01-1
INTRODUCTION
-
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
010QH-01
GENERAL INFORMATION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
2.
(a)
3.
(a)
4.
(a)
(b)
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
This manual is written in accordance with SAE J2008.
Repair operations can be separated into 3 main processes:
1. Diagnosis
2. Removing/Installing, Replacing, Disassembling/Reassembling, Checking and Adjusting
3. Final Inspection
This manual explains the ”Diagnosis” (found in the ”Diagnostics” section) and ”Removing and Installing, Replacing, Disassembling, Installing and Checking, and Adjusting”. ”Final Inspection” is omitted.
The following essential operations are not written in this manual. However, these operations must be
performed in actual situations.
(1) Operations with a jack or lift
(2) Cleaning of a removed part when necessary
(3) Visual check
INDEX
An alphabetical INDEX section is provided at the end of the book as a reference to help you find the
item to be repaired.
PREPARATION
Use of Special Service Tools (SST) and Special Service Materials (SSM) may be required, depending
on the repair situation. Be sure to use SST and SSM when they are required and follow the working
procedure properly. A list of SST and SSM is in the Preparation section of this manual.
REPAIR PROCEDURES
A component illustration is placed under the title where necessary.
Non-reusable parts, grease application areas, precoated parts and torque specifications are noted
in the component illustrations.
Example:
Filler Cap
Float
Clevis Pin
Gasket
Reservoir Tank
Boot
Grommet
Slotted Spring Pin
Clip
12 (120, 9)
Clevis
15 (155, 11)
Snap Ring
Washer
Lock Nut
Push Rod
Piston
Cylinder
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
N17080
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1
01-2
INTRODUCTION
-
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
(c)
Torque specifications, grease application areas, and non-reusable parts are emphasized in the procedures.
NOTICE:
There are cases where such information can only be explained by using an illustration. In these
cases, all the information such as torque, oil, etc. are described in the illustration.
(d) The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
(e) Only items with key points are described in the text. What to do and other details are placed in illustrations next to the text. Both the text and illustrations are accompanied by standard values and notices.
(f)
Illustrations of similar vehicle models are sometimes used. In those cases, specific details may be different from the actual vehicle.
(g) Procedures are presented in a step-by-step format:
(1) The illustration shows what to do and where to do it.
(2) The task heading tells what to do.
(3) The explanation text tells how to perform the task. It also has information such as specifications
and warnings.
Example:
Illustration:
D31332
what to do and where
Task heading: what you will be doing
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB BEARING
Detailed text: how to perform task
Set part No.
Component part No.
B80366
HINT:
This format provides an experienced technician with a FAST TRACK to the necessary information. The task
headings are easy to read and the text below the task heading provides detailed information. Important specifications and warnings are always written in bold type.
5.
(a)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS are presented in bold-faced text throughout the manual. The specifications are
also found in the Service Specifications section for quick reference.
6.
TERMS DEFINITION
CAUTION
NOTICE
HINT
Possibility of injury to you or other people.
Possibility of damage to the components being repaired.
Provides additional information to help you perform repairs.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2
01-3
INTRODUCTION
7.
(a)
-
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
SI UNIT
The units used in this manual comply with the SI UNIT (International System of Units) standard. Units
from the metric system and the English system are also provided.
Example:
Torque: 30 N⋅m (310 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3
01-4
INTRODUCTION
-
IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
010QI-01
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION AND SERIAL NUMBERS
1.
(a)
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The vehicle identification number is stamped on the vehicle identification number plate and certification label, as
shown in the illustration.
A: Vehicle Identification Number Plate
B: Certification Label
2.
ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER AND TRANSAXLE SERIAL
NUMBER
The engine serial number is stamped on the cylinder
block of the engine and the transmission serial number is
stamped on the housing as shown in the illustration.
A: 3MZ-FE
B: 2AZ-FE
C: U140E, U151E, U151F, U241E
A
B
D25521
(a)
A
B
C
D25520
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
4
01-21
INTRODUCTION
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
010QK-02
VEHICLE LIFT AND SUPPORT LOCATIONS
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
3.
(a)
NOTICE ABOUT VEHICLE CONDITION WHEN JACKING UP THE VEHICLE
The vehicle must be unloaded before jacking up the vehicle. Never jack up/lift up a heavily loaded vehicle.
When removing heavy equipment such as the engine and transmission, the center of gravity of the
vehicle may shift. To stabilize the vehicle: place a balance weight in a location where it will not roll or
shift; or use a mission jack to hold the jacking support.
NOTICE FOR USING 4 POST LIFTS
Follow the safety procedures outlined in its instruction manual.
Use precautionary measures to prevent the free wheel beam from damaging tires or wheels.
Use wheel chocks to secure the vehicle.
NOTICE FOR USING JACK AND SAFETY STAND
Work in a flat area using wheel chocks at all times.
(b)
Rubber Attachment
(c)
(d)
D25523
(f)
(g)
(e)
Use a safety stand with a rubber attachment, as shown
in the illustration.
Apply the jack and rigid rack to the specified location on
the vehicle.
When jacking up the front wheels, release the parking
brake and place wheel chocks only behind the rear
wheels. When jacking up the rear wheels, place wheel
chocks only in front of the front wheels.
The jack should not be used without the rigid rack.
When jacking up only the front wheels or only the rear wheels, place wheel chocks on both sides of
the wheels touching the ground.
When lowering the vehicle with its front wheels jacked up, release the parking brake and place wheel
chocks only in front of the rear wheels. When lowering a vehicle with its rear wheels jacked up, place
wheel chocks only behind the front wheels.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
21
01-22
INTRODUCTION
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
2WD
Center of Wheel
1,080 mm
(42.52 in.)
4WD
1,110 mm
Center of Wheel (43.70 in.)
: JACK POSITION
: SUPPORT POSITION, PANTOGRAPH JACK POSITION
: CENTER OF VEHICLE GRAVITY (unload condition)
D27508
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
22
01-23
INTRODUCTION
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
NOTICE FOR USING SWING ARM TYPE LIFT
Follow safety procedures outlined in its instruction manual.
Use a swing arm equipped with a rubber attachment, as shown in the illustration.
When using the lift, its center should be as close to the vehicle’s center of gravity as possible.
Set the vehicle on the lift as level as possible. Then match the groove of the cradle to the rigid rack
support location.
Be sure to lock the swing arms before lifting and during work (if equipped with arm locks).
Lift the vehicle up off the ground. Stand at a safe distance and shake the vehicle to check its stability.
Rubber Attachment
Center of Lift
Center of Wheel
*
L
* ... 2WD:
1,080 mm (42.52 in.)
4WD:
1,110 mm (43.70 in.)
: CENTER OF VEHICLE
GRAVITY (unload condition)
D25518
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
23
01-24
INTRODUCTION
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
NOTICE FOR USING PLATE TYPE LIFT
Follow safety procedures outlined in its instruction manual.
Use plate lift attachments (rubber lifting blocks) on top of the plate surface.
Refer to the table below to determine how to properly set the vehicle.
Right and left set position
Place the vehicle over the center of the lift.
Front and rear set position
Place the attachments at the ends of the rubber plate surface, under the vehicle lift pad (A and C in the illustration). Raise the plate slightly and reposition the vehicle so the top of the attachment (B in the illustration) is
aligned with the front side notch in the vehicle rocker flange.
(d)
Lift the vehicle up off the ground, and shake it to make sure that it is stable.
B
C
A
Attachment Dimensions
85 mm (3.35 in.)
70 mm (2.76 in.)
100 mm (3.94 in.)
200 mm (7.87 in.)
D25522
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
24
01-5
INTRODUCTION
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
010QJ-02
PRECAUTION
(b)
HINTS ON OPERATIONS
2
1
3
6
5
4
D25016
1
Looks
Always wear a clean uniform.
Hat and safety shoes must be worn.
2
Vehicle protection
Prepare a grille cover, fender cover, seat cover and floor mat before starting the operation.
3
Safe operation
When working with 2 or more persons, be sure to check safety for one another.
When working with the engine running, pay attention to providing ventilation for exhaust fumes in the
workshop.
If working on high temperature, high pressure, rotating, moving, or vibrating parts, wear appropriate safety
equipment and take extra care not to injure yourself or others.
When jacking up the vehicle, be sure to support the specified location with a safety stand.
When lifting up the vehicle, use appropriate safety equipment.
4
Preparation of tools and
measuring gauge
Before starting operation, prepare a tool stand, SST, gauge, oil, shop rag and parts for replacement.
Removal and installation,
disassembly and assembly operations
Diagnose with a thorough understanding of proper procedures and of the reported problem.
Before removing the parts, check the general condition of the assembly and for deformation and damage.
When the assembly is complicated, take notes. For example, note the total number of electrical connections,
bolts, or hoses removed. Add matchmarks to insure re-assembly of components in the original positions.
Temporarily mark hoses and their fittings, if needed.
Clean and wash the removed parts if necessary and assemble them after a thorough check.
Removed parts
Place the removed parts in a separate box to avoid mixing them up with the new parts or contaminating the
new parts.
As for non-reusable parts such as a gasket, an O-ring, and a self-locking nut, replace them with new ones
following the instructions in this manual.
Retain the removed parts for customer inspection, if requested.
5
6
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
5
01-6
INTRODUCTION
(c)
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
JACKING UP AND SUPPORTING VEHICLE
(1) Care must be taken when jacking up and supporting the vehicle. Be sure to lift and support the
vehicle at the proper locations (see page 01-21 ).
(d)
Seal Lock Adhesive
Z11554
PRECOATED PARTS
(1) Precoated parts are bolts and nuts, that are coated
with a seal lock adhesive at the factory.
(2) If a precoated part is retightened, loosened or
moved in anyway, it must be recoated with the specified adhesive.
(3) When reusing precoated parts, clean off the old
adhesive and dry the part with compressed air.
Then apply new seal lock adhesive appropriate to
the bolts and nut.
NOTICE:
Perform the torque with the lower limit value of the torque
tolerance.
(4) Some seal lock agents harden slowly. You may
have to wait for the seal lock agent to harden.
(e)
GASKETS
(1) When necessary, use a sealer on gaskets to prevent leaks.
(f)
BOLTS, NUTS AND SCREWS
(1) Carefully follow all the specifications for tightening torques. Always use a torque wrench.
(g) FUSES
Medium Current Fuse and High Current
(1) When replacing fuses, be sure that the new fuse
Fuse
Equal Amperage Rating
has the correct amperage rating. DO NOT exceed
the rating or use one with a lower rating.
BE1367
Illustration
Symbol
Abbreviation
Part Name
FUSE
FUSE
MEDIUM CURRENT FUSE
M-FUSE
HIGH CURRENT FUSE
H-FUSE
D27353
V35002
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
6
01-7
INTRODUCTION
(h)
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
CLIPS
(1) The removal and installation methods of typical clips used in body parts are shown in the table
below.
HINT:
If clips are damaged during a procedure, always replace the damaged clip with a new clip.
Shape (Example)
Removal/Installation
Clip
Pliers
Clip Remover
Remove clips from front or rear using clip remover
or pliers.
Protective Tape
Screwdriver
Remove fasteners with a clip remover or screwdriver.
Protective Tape
Scraper
Remove clips with a wide scraper to prevent
panel damage.
D25786
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
7
01-8
INTRODUCTION
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Removal/Installation
Shape (Example)
Removal
Installation
Screwdriver
Push
Clip Remover
Remove rivet by pushing the center pin through and prying
out the rivet shell.
Removal
Installation
Screwdriver
Push
Clip Remover
Remove rivet by unscrewing the center pin and prying out
the rivet shell.
Removal
Installation
Push
Screwdriver
Clip Remover
Small Clip Remover
Remove rivet by prying out the pin and then prying out the
rivet shell.
V35006
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
8
01-9
INTRODUCTION
(i)
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF VACUUM HOSES
(1) To disconnect vacuum hoses, pull and twist from
the end of the hose. Do not pull from the middle of
the hose as this may cause damage.
CORRECT
INCORRECT
-
D31750
(2)
(3)
(4)
D25064
(j)
L1
TORQUE WHEN USING TORQUE WRENCH WITH EXTENSION TOOL
(1) If SST or an extension tool is combined with the
torque wrench to extend its length, do not tighten
the torque wrench to the specified torque values in
this manual. The resulting torque will be excessive.
(2) Use the formula below to calculate special torque
values for situations where SST or an extension tool
is combined with the torque wrench.
(3) Formula: T’ = T x L2/(L1 + L2)
L2
D02612
L1
L2
When disconnecting vacuum hoses, use tags to
identify where they should be reconnected.
After completing the job, double check that the vacuum hoses are properly connected. The label under
the hood shows the proper layout.
When using a vacuum gauge, never force the hose
onto a connector that is too large. Use a step-down
adapter for adjustment. Once the hose has been
stretched, it may leak air.
T’
Reading of torque wrench {N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)}
T
Torque {N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)}
L1
Length of SST or extension tool (cm)
L2
Length of torque wrench (cm)
D01201
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
9
01-10
INTRODUCTION
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
1.
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH SRS AIRBAG AND SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
HINT:
The HIGHLANDER is equipped with a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) and seat belt pretensioner.
Failure to carry out the service operations in the correct sequence could cause the SRS to unexpectedly
deploy during servicing and lead to serious injury.
Furthermore, if a mistake is made when servicing the SRS, it is possible that the SRS may fail to operate
properly. Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to
read the following section carefully.
(a) GENERAL NOTICE
(1) Malfunction symptoms of the SRS are difficult to confirm so the Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs)
become the most important source of information when troubleshooting. When troubleshooting
the SRS, always check the DTCs before disconnecting the battery (see page 05-1215 ).
(2) To avoid serious injury, servicing the SRS must be started at least 90 seconds after:
The ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position.
The negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
(The SRS is equipped with a back-up power source. If work is started within 90 seconds of disconnecting the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, the SRS may deploy.)
Disconnecting the negative (-) terminal cable will erase the memory of all vehicle systems. Initialize the systems after disconnecting/reconnecting the cable.
CAUTION:
Never use a back-up power source (battery or other) in an attempt to avoid erasing system memory.
The back-up power source inadvertently may inadvertently power the SRS and cause it to deploy.
(3) In minor collisions where the SRS does not deploy, the horn button assembly, instrument panel
passenger airbag assembly, front seat airbag assembly, curtain shield airbag assembly and seat
belt pretensioner should be inspected before further use of the vehicle (see pages 60-19 ,
60-31 , 60-40 , 60-46 , and 61-8 ).
(4) Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, use new parts.
(5) Before repairs, remove the airbag sensor if impacts are likely to be applied to the sensor during
repairs.
(6) Never disassemble and repair the airbag sensor assembly, horn button assembly, instrument
panel passenger airbag assembly, front seat airbag assembly, curtain shield airbag assembly
or seat belt pretensioner.
(7) Replace the center airbag sensor assembly, side airbag sensor assembly, horn button assembly
or the instrument panel passenger airbag assembly, front seat airbag assembly or curtain shield
airbag assembly if: 1) damage has occurred from being dropped, or 2) cracks, dents or other
defects in the case, bracket or connector are present.
(8) Do not directly expose the airbag sensor assembly, the horn button assembly, the instrument
panel passenger airbag assembly, front seat airbag assembly, the curtain shield airbag assembly or the seat belt pretensioner to hot air or flames.
(9) Use a voltmeter/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V minimum) for troubleshooting electrical circuits.
(10) Information labels are attached to the SRS components. Follow the instructions on the labels.
(11) After work on the SRS is completed, check the SRS warning light (see page 05-1207 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
10
01-1 1
INTRODUCTION
(b)
Mark
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
SPIRAL CABLE (in Combination Switch)
(1) The steering wheel must be fitted correctly to the
steering column with the spiral cable at the neutral
position, otherwise cable disconnection and other
problems may occur. Refer to page 60-26 for information about correct installation of the steering
wheel.
D30401
(c)
HORN BUTTON ASSEMBLY (with Airbag)
(1) When removing the horn button assembly or handling a new horn button, it should be placed with
the pad surface facing up. See illustration below.
Placing the horn button with the pad surface facing down may lead to a serious accident if the
airbag accidently inflates. Also, do not place anything on top of the horn button.
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib. This may cause the airbag to inflate, which
could cause serious injury.
(3) Grease or detergents of any kind should not be applied to the steering wheel pad.
(4) Store the horn button assembly in an area where the ambient temperature is below 93°C
(200°F), the humidity is not high and electrical noise is not nearby.
(5) When using electric welding anywhere on the vehicle, disconnect the airbag ECU connectors
(4 pins). These connectors contain shorting springs. This feature reduces the possibility of the
airbag or seat belt pretensioner deploying due to currents entering the squib wiring.
(6) When disposing of the vehicle or the horn button assembly by itself, the airbag should be inflated
using an SST before disposal (see page 60-19 ). Perform the operation in a safe place away from
electrical noise.
Example:
CORRECT
INCORRECT
D25096
Example:
NEVER USE AN OHMMETER ON AN AIRBAG OR PRETENSIONER
Z13950
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
11
01-12
INTRODUCTION
(d)
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
INSTRUMENT PANEL PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(1) Always place a removed or new instrument panel passenger airbag assembly with the airbag
inflation direction facing up.
Placing the airbag assembly with the airbag inflation direction facing down could cause a serious
accident if the airbag inflates.
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib. This may cause the airbag to inflate, which
could cause serious injury.
(3) Grease or detergents of any kinds should not be applied to the instrument panel passenger airbag assembly.
(4) Store the airbag assembly in an area where the ambient temperature is below 93°C (200°F),
the humidity is not high and electrical noise is not nearby.
(5) When using electric welding anywhere on the vehicle, disconnect the airbag ECU connectors
(4 pins). These connectors contain shorting springs. This feature reduces the possibility of the
airbag deploying due to currents entering the squib wiring.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the airbag assembly unit by itself, the airbag should be deployed
using SST before disposal (see page 60-31 ).
Activate in a safe place away from electrical noise.
Example:
CORRECT
INCORRECT
D27522
Example:
NEVER USE AN OHMMETER ON AN AIRBAG OR PRETENSIONER
Z13951
(e)
CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(1) Always place the removed or new curtain shield airbag assembly in a clear plastic bag, and keep
it in a safe place.
NOTICE:
Plastic bag is not re-useable.
CAUTION:
Never disassemble the curtain shield airbag assembly.
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib. This may cause the airbag to inflate, which
is very dangerous.
(3) Grease should not be attached to the curtain shield airbag assembly, and the surface should not
be cleared with detergents of any kind.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
12
01-13
INTRODUCTION
(4)
(5)
(6)
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Store the airbag assembly in an area where the ambient temperature is below 93°C (200°F),
the humidity is not high and electrical noise is not nearby.
When using electric welding anywhere on the vehicle, disconnect the airbag ECU connectors
(2 pins). These connectors contain shorting springs. This feature reduces the possibility of the
airbag deploying due to currents entering the squib wiring.
When disposing of a vehicle or the curtain shield airbag assembly unit, the airbag should be
deployed using SST before disposal (see page 60-40 ).
Activate in a safe place away from electrical noise.
Example:
CORRECT
INCORRECT
Clear Plastic Bag
D31641
NEVER USE AN OHMMETER ON AN AIRBAG OR PRETENSIONER
(f)
D30931
FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(1) Always place a removed or new front seat airbag assembly with the airbag inflation direction facing up. Placing the airbag assembly with the airbag inflation direction facing downward could
cause a serious accident if the airbag deploys.
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib. This may cause the airbag to inflate, which
is very dangerous.
(3) Grease should not be applied to the front seat airbag assembly, and the airbag door should not
be cleaned with detergents of any kind.
(4) Store the airbag assembly in an area where the ambient temperature is below 93°C (200°F),
the humidity is not high and electrical noise is not nearby.
(5) When using electric welding anywhere on the vehicle, disconnect the airbag ECU connectors
(2 pins). These connectors contain shorting springs. This feature reduces the possibility of the
airbag deploying due to currents entering the squib wiring.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the airbag assembly unit by itself, the airbag should be deployed
using SST before disposal (see page 60-46 ).
Activate in a safe place away from electrical noise.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
13
01-14
INTRODUCTION
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Example:
NEVER USE AN OHMMETER ON AN AIRBAG OR PRETENSIONER
(g)
D30924
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
(1) Never measure the resistance of the seat belt pretensioner. This may cause the seat belt pretensioner to activate, which is very dangerous.
(2) Never disassemble the seat belt pretensioner.
(3) Never install the seat belt pretensioner on another vehicle.
(4) Store the seat belt pretensioner in area where the ambient temperature is below 80°C (176°F),
the humidity is not high and electrical noise is not nearby.
(5) When using electric welding anywhere on the vehicle, disconnect the airbag ECU connectors
(2 pins). These connectors contain shorting springs. This feature reduces the possibility of the
airbag deploying due to currents entering the squib wiring.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the seat belt pretensioner unit by itself, the seat belt pretensioner
should be activated before disposal (see page 61-8 ). Activate in a safe place away from electrical noise.
(7) The seat belt pretensioner is hot after being activated, so allow some time for it to cool down sufficiently before disposal. Never apply water to cool down the seat belt pretensioner.
(8) Oil or water should not be put on the front seat outer belt, and the front seat outer belt should
not be cleaned with detergents of any kind.
Example:
NEVER USE AN OHMMETER ON AN AIRBAG OR PRETENSIONER
(h)
D30370
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(1) Never reuse an airbag sensor assembly that has been involved in a collision where the SRS has
deployed.
(2) The connectors to the airbag sensor assembly should be connected or disconnected with the
sensor mounted on the floor. If the connectors are connected or disconnected while the airbag
sensor assembly is not mounted to the floor, it could cause accidental deployment of the SRS.
(3) Work must be started at least 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position
and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, even if only loosening the
set bolts of the airbag sensor assembly.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
14
01-15
INTRODUCTION
(i)
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
(1) The SRS wire harness is integrated with the instrument panel wire harness assembly. All the connectors in the system are a standard yellow color. If the SRS wire harness becomes disconnected or the connector becomes broken, repair or replace it.
Negative (-)
Terminal
2.
(a)
ELECTRONIC CONTROL
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF BATTERY TERMINAL
(1) Before performing electronic work, disconnect the
battery negative (-) terminal cable beforehand to
prevent component and wire damage caused by
accidental short circuits.
(2) When disconnecting and installing the terminal
cable, turn the ignition switch and lighting switch
OFF and loosen the terminal nut completely. Perform these operations without twisting or prying the
terminal. Remove the battery cable from battery
post.
(3) Clock settings, radio settings, DTCs and other data
are erased when the battery cable is removed. Before removing the battery cable, record any necessary data.
(4) When disconnecting the battery’s negative (-) terminal cable, re-initialize the following systems after
the completion of the operation.
(b)
HANDLING OF ELECTRONIC PARTS
(1) Do not open the cover or case of the ECU unless
absolutely necessary. If the IC terminals are
touched, the IC may be rendered inoperative by
static electricity.
(2) To disconnect electronic connectors, pull the connector itself, not the wires.
(3) Be careful not to drop electronic components, such
as sensors or relays. If they are dropped on a hard
floor, they should be replaced.
(4) When cleaning the engine with steam, protect the
electronic components, air filter and emission-related components from water.
(5) Never use an impact wrench to remove or install
temperature switches or temperature sensors.
(6) When checking the continuity at the wire connector,
insert the tester probe carefully to prevent terminals
from bending.
D25080
INCORRECT
D31751
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
15
01-16
INTRODUCTION
3.
(a)
(b)
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF FUEL CONTROL PARTS
PLACE FOR REMOVING AND INSTALLING OF FUEL SYSTEM PARTS
(1) Work in a place with good air ventilation and without any ignition sources, such as a welder, grinder, drill, electric motor or stove.
(2) Never work in a place such as a pit or near a pit because vaporized fuel will collect in those places.
REMOVING AND INSTALLING OF FUEL SYSTEM PARTS
(1) Prepare a fire extinguisher before starting operation.
(2) To prevent static electricity, install a ground on the fuel changer, vehicle and fuel tank, and do
not spray the area with water. The work surface will become slippery. Do not clean up spills with
water as this will spread and gasoline and create a fire hazard.
(3) Never use any electric equipment like an electric motor or a working light, as they may create
sparks or high temperatures.
(4) Never use an iron hammer, as it may create sparks.
(5) Dispose of fuel-contaminated shop rags separately using a fire resistant container.
4.
(a)
(b)
D01563
(c)
Spring Type Clamp
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Clamp Track
D25081
6.
(a)
(b)
D20025
(c)
(d)
(e)
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF ENGINE INTAKE
PARTS
If any metal particle enters the inlet pass, this may damage the engine.
When removing and installing the inlet system parts, cover the openings of the removed parts and engine openings. Use clean shop rags, gummed tape, or other suitable materials.
When installing the inlet system parts, check that no metal
particles have entered the engine or the installed part.
HANDLING OF HOSE CLAMPS
Before removing the hose, check the clamp position so
that you can restore it in the same way.
Replace deformed or dented clamps with new ones.
When reusing a hose, attach the clamp on the clamp track
portion of the hose.
For a spring type clamp, to spread the tabs slightly after
installation by pushing in the direction of the arrow marks
as shown in the illustration.
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH MOBILE COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS
Install the antenna as far away from the ECU and sensors
of the vehicle electronic systems as possible.
Install an antenna feeder at least 20 cm (7.87 in.) away
from the ECU and sensors of the vehicle electronic systems. For details of the ECU and sensors locations, refer
to the section on applicable components.
Keep the antenna and feeder separate from other wirings
as much as possible. This will prevent signals from the
communication equipment from affecting vehicle equipment and vice-versa.
Check that the antenna and feeder are correctly adjusted.
Do not install any high-powered mobile communication
system.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
16
01-17
INTRODUCTION
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
7.
(a)
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH TRACTION CONTROL (TRAC) SYSTEM
When testing with a 2-wheel drum tester such as a speedometer tester, a combination tester of the
speedometer and brake, a chassis dynamometer, or when jacking up the front wheels and driving the
wheels, always turn the TRAC system OFF beforehand via the TRAC OFF switch before testing.
NOTICE:
TRAC system OFF condition can be confirmed by the ”TRAC OFF” warning indicator light in the combination meter.
8.
DLC3
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 1314 1516
TS
A82779
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH VEHICLE SKID
CONTROL (VSC) SYSTEM
(a) NOTICES WHEN USING DRUM TESTER
(1) Before beginning testing, disable the Vehicle Skid
Control system (VSC). To disable the VSC, turn the
ignition switch OFF and connect SST to terminals
TS and CG of DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
NOTICE:
Confirm that the VSC warning light blinks.
VSC system will be reset when the engine is restarted.
For safety, secure the vehicle with restraint chains
while using a wheel dynamometer.
(b)
NOTICES OF RELATED OPERATIONS TO VSC
(1) Do not carry out unnecessary installation and removal as it might affect the adjustment of VSC related parts.
(2) Be sure to follow the instructions for work preparation and final confirmation of proper operation of the
VSC system.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
17
01-18
INTRODUCTION
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
9.
WHEN SERVICING FULL-TIME 4WD VEHICLES
(a) MEASURING POINTS FOR SPEEDOMETER TESTER
NOTICE:
Tester with a function of load setting cannot be used.
Inspection should be done in the front wheels.
Do not start, accelerate nor decelerate the vehicle suddenly.
Maximum vehicle speed must be below 60 km/h (when using free roller, it must be below 50
km/h).
Driving time should be within 1 minute.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
D25530
Place the front wheels onto the rollers.
Set the rear wheels free by free rollers or rigid racks.
Fasten the vehicle with the lock chain.
Start the engine, and then measure the vehicle
speed by increasing the speed gradually in the D
range.
After the measurement completion, decrease the
vehicle speed by brake gradually, and then stop the
vehicle.
D25531
(b) MEASURING POINTS FOR BRAKE TESTER
NOTICE:
Tester with a function of load measurement cannot be used
High-speed type brake cannot be used.
(1) Place the wheels to be measured (front or rear) onto the rollers.
(2) Shift the shift lever into neutral.
(3) Perform the measurement by driving the tester rollers.
HINT:
In case that the dragging force is over 10% of the load put on the axis, inspection of the wheel’s rotating
condition should be done with both of the left and right axes jacked up. If no abnormality is found in the rotating condition, adhesive torque of the viscous coupling causes the excessive dragging fore and therefore it
means no problem exists in the vehicle.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
18
01-19
INTRODUCTION
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(c)
MEASURING POINTS FOR ON-VEHICLE BALANCER
(1) Jack up all 4 wheels with 2 post lifts.
(2) Fasten the vehicle by setting 2 pick-up stands in the
bottom of suspension arm’s tip of the front wheels
or rear wheels to be measured.
(3) Support the vehicle with rigid racks so that vehicle
will not lean in the vehicle’s front/rear direction.
(4) Release the parking brake.
(5) Check that no dragging force exists by turning each
D25532
wheel by hand.
(6) Set the wheel balancers.
(7) Measurement should be done by using both of engine drive and wheel balancer roller drive.
NOTICE:
Start the engine, and then increase the vehicle speed
gradually in the D range.
Do not accelerate nor decelerate suddenly.
Deceleration should be done by brake gradually.
Take special care that the vehicle does not move.
Measurement should be done quickly.
10. FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH CATALYTIC CONVERTER
CAUTION:
If a large amount of unburned gasoline or gasoline vapors flow into the converter, it may cause oveheating and create a fire hazard. To prevent this, observe the following precautions.
(a) Use only unleaded gasoline.
(b) Avoid prolonged idling.
Avoid idling the engine for more than 20 minutes.
(c) Avoid a spark jump test.
(1) Perform a spark jump test only when absolutely necessary. Perform this test as rapidly as possible.
(2) While testing, never race the engine.
(d) Avoid a prolonged engine compression measurement.
Engine compression measurements must be performed as rapidly as possible.
(e) Do not run the engine when the fuel tank is nearly empty. This may cause the engine to misfire and
create an extra load on the converter.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
19
01-20
INTRODUCTION
-
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
11.
(a)
INCORRECT
D25533
INCORRECT
WHEN TOWING FULL-TIME 4WD VEHICLES
Tow the vehicles with the 4 wheels touching the ground
or the 4 wheels held up. In case that an abnormality exists
in the chassis and drive train, tow the vehicle with the 4
wheels held up.
(b) Never tow the vehicle with either condition of the front
wheels only or the rear only held up.
NOTICE:
Towing with either condition of the front wheels only the
rear wheels only held up might cause the drive train
burned-out or the wheels flying off the dolly.
D25534
(c)
Flat Bed Truck
(d)
Towing the vehicle should be done by one of the towing
methods as shown in the illustration.
If the vehicle has a trouble in the chassis or drive train, use
the wheel lift type truck.
Parking Brake
Transaxle Shift
Lever Position
Flat Bed Truck
Applied
Any Position
Wheel Lift Type Truck
Applied
Any Position
Towing Method
Wheel Lift Type Truck
NOTICE:
Do not use any towing method other those shown above.
D25529
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
20
01-36
INTRODUCTION
-
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
010QN-01
ELECTRONIC CIRCUIT INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1.
(a)
BASIC INSPECTION
RESISTANCE MEASURING CONDITION OF ELECTRONIC PARTS
(1) Unless stated, all resistance is measured at an ambient temperature of 20C (68F). Resistances measured may be outside the specifications if measured at high temperatures, i.e. immediately after the vehicle has been running. Measurements should be made after the engine
has cooled down.
(b)
INCORRECT
INCORRECT
CORRECT
D32092
Looseness of Crimping
Core Wire
Terminal
Deformation
Pull Lightly
D25087
HANDLING CONNECTORS
(1) When disconnecting a connector, first squeeze the
mating halves tightly together to release the lock,
then press the lock claw and separate the connector.
(2) When disconnecting a connector, do not pull on the
harnesses. Grasp the connector directly and separate it.
(3) Before connecting the connector, check that there
are no deformed, damaged, loose or missing terminals.
(4) When connecting a connector, press firmly until you
hear the lock close with a ”click” sound.
(5) If checking the connector with a TOYOTA electrical
tester, check it from the backside (harness side) of
the connector using a mini test lead.
NOTICE:
As a waterproof connector cannot be checked from
the backside, check by connecting a sub-harness.
Do not damage the terminals by moving the inserted
tester needle.
(c) CHECKING CONNECTORS
(1) Checking when the connector is connected:
Squeeze the connector together to confirm that it is
fully inserted and locked.
(2) Checking when the connector is disconnected:
Check by pulling the wire harness lightly from the
backside of the connector. Look for unlatched terminals, missing terminals, loose crimps or broken conductor wires.
Check visually for corrosion, metallic or foreign objects and water; and bent, rusted, overheated, contaminated, and deformed terminals.
NOTICE:
When testing a gold-plated female terminal, always use a
gold-plated male terminal.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
36
INTRODUCTION
-
(3)
Same terminal as
a male terminal
INCORRECT
INCORRECT
REPAIR METHOD OF CONNECTOR TERMINAL
(1) If there is any dirt on the terminal, clean the contact
point using an air gun or shop rag. Never polish the
contact point using sandpaper as the platings may
come off.
(2) If there is abnormal contact pressure, replace the
female terminal. If the male terminal is gold-plated
(gold color), use a gold-plated female terminal; if it
is silver-plated (silver color), use a silver-plated female terminal.
(3) Damaged, deformed, or corroded terminals should
be replaced. If the terminal will not lock into the
housing, the housing may have to be replaced.
(e)
HANDLING OF WIRE HARNESS
(1) If removing a wire harness, check the wiring and
clamping before proceeding so that it can be restored in the same way.
(2) Never twist, pull or slacken the wire harness more
than necessary.
(3) Never make the wire harness come into contact
with a high temperature part, rotating, moving, vibrating or sharp-edged parts. Avoid panel edges,
screw tips and similar sharp items.
(4) When installing parts, never pinch the wire harness.
(5) Never cut or break the cover of the wire harness. If
it is cut or broken, replace it or securely repair it with
vinyl tape.
2.
(a)
CHECK OPEN CIRCUIT
For an open circuit in the wire harness in Fig. 1, perform
a resistance check (step b) or a voltage check (step c).
D32094
Fig. 1
ECU
C
Sensor
OPEN
1
1
2
2
Checking the contact pressure of the terminal:
Prepare a spare male terminal. Insert it into a female terminal, and check for good tension when inserting and after full engagement.
(d)
D32093
INCORRECT
01-37
D25088
INCORRECT
CORRECT
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
B
A
1
2
1
2
Z17004
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
37
01-38
INTRODUCTION
(b)
Fig. 2
ECU
Sensor
1
2
C
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
Check the resistance.
(1) Disconnect connectors A and C and measure the
resistance between them.
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
HINT:
Measure the resistance while lightly shaking the wire harness
vertically and horizontally.
Fig. 2:
1
2
A
1
2
B
-
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 Connector C terminal 1
10 kΩ or higher
Connector A terminal 2 Connector C terminal 2
Below 1 kΩ
Z17005
If your results match the examples above, an open circuit exists
between terminal 1 of connector A and terminal 1 of connector
C.
(2)
Fig. 3
ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 Connector B1 terminal 1
Below 1 kΩ
Connector B2 terminal 1 Connector C terminal 1
10 kΩ or higher
Sensor
1
2
B2
1
2
C
1
1
2
2
A
B1
B04722
If your results match the examples above, an open circuit exists
between terminal 1 of connector B2 and terminal 1 of connector
C.
(c)
Fig. 4
5V
Sensor 0V
1
5V
1
2
C
1
2
B
2
A
Z17007
Disconnect connector B and measure the resistance between the connectors.
Fig. 3:
Check the voltage.
(1) In a circuit in which voltage is applied to the ECU
connector terminal, an open circuit can be checked
by conducting a voltage check.
Fig. 4:
With each connector still connected, measure the
voltage between the body ground these terminals
(in this order): 1) terminal 1 of connector A at the
ECU 5V output terminal, 2) terminal 1 of connector
B, and 3) terminal 1 of connector C.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
38
INTRODUCTION
-
(2)
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
01-39
Example results:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 -
5V
Body ground
Connector B terminal 1 -
5V
Body ground
Connector C terminal 1 -
0V
Body ground
If your results match the examples above, an open circuit exists
in the wire harness between terminal 1 of B and terminal 1 of
C.
Fig. 5
C SHORT
1
2
B
1
2
3.
(a)
CHECK SHORT CIRCUIT
If the wire harness is ground shorted (Fig. 5), locate the
section by conducting a resistance check with the body
ground (below).
(b)
Check the resistance with the body ground.
(1) Disconnect connectors A and C and measure the
resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of connector
A and the body ground.
Resistance: 10 kΩ or higher
A
1
2
Z17008
Fig. 6
ECU
Sensor
1
2
C
1
2
B
1
2
A
Z17009
HINT:
Measure the resistance while lightly shaking the wire harness
vertically and horizontally.
Fig. 6:
Tester Connection
Connector A terminal 1 Body ground
Connector A terminal 2 Connector C terminal 2
Specified Condition
Below 1 kΩ
10 kΩ or higher
If your results match the examples above, a short circuit exists
between terminal 1 of connector A and terminal 1 of connector
C.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
39
01-40
INTRODUCTION
(2)
Fig. 7
ECU
Sensor
1
2
C
1
2
B2
1
2
B1
1
2
-
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
Disconnect connector B and measure the resistance between terminal 1 of connector A and the
body ground, and terminal 1 of connector B2 and
the body ground.
Fig. 7:
Tester Connection
Connector A terminal 1 -
A
Body ground
Z17808
Connector B2 terminal 1 Body ground
Specified Condition
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 kΩ
If your results match the examples above, a short
circuit exists between terminal 1 of connector B2
and terminal 1 of connector C.
4.
CHECK AND REPLACE ECU
NOTICE:
The connector should not be disconnected from the
ECU. Perform the inspection from the backside of the
connector on the wire harness side.
When no measuring condition is specified, perform
the inspection with the engine stopped and the ignition switch ON.
Check that the connectors are fully seated. Check for
loose, corroded or broken wires.
(a) First check the ECU ground circuit. If it is faulty, repair it.
If it is normal, the ECU could be faulty. Replace the ECU
with a normal functioning one and check if the symptoms
occur. If the trouble symptoms stop, replace the ECU.
(1)
Measure the resistance between the ECU ground
terminal and body ground.
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Example
Ground
IN0383
(2)
ECU Side
Ground
W/H Side
Disconnect the ECU connector. Check the ground
terminals (on the ECU side and wire harness side)
for evidence of bending, corrosion or foreign material. Lastly check the contact pressure of the female
terminals.
Ground
IN0384
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
40
INTRODUCTION
-
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
01-25
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
010QL-02
GENERAL INFORMATION
A large number of ECU controlled systems are used in the HIGHLANDER. In general, ECU controlled systems are considered to be very intricate, requiring a high level of technical knowledge to troubleshoot. However, most problem checking procedures only involve inspecting the ECU controlled system’s circuits one
by one. An adequate understanding of the system and a basic knowledge of electricity is enough to perform
effective troubleshooting, accurate diagnoses and necessary repairs. Detailed information and troubleshooting procedures on major ECU controlled systems in this vehicle are outlined below:
System
See Page
1. SFI System (2AZ-FE)
05-1
2. SFI System (3MZ-FE)
05-362
3. Tire Pressure Warning System
05-729
4. ABS with EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC System
05-761
5. Electronic Controlled Automatic Transaxle [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-876
6. Electronic Controlled Automatic Transaxle [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-986
7. Air Conditioning System
05-1114
8. Supplement Restraint System
05-1194
9. Lighting System
05-1526
10. Audio System
05-1611
11. Rear Seat Entertaiment System
05-1690
12. Navigation System
05-1749
13. Combination Meter
05-1868
14. Power Window Control System
05-1901
15. Power Door Lock Control System
05-1934
16. Wireless Door Lock Control System
05-1960
17. Sliding Roof System
05-1974
18. Engine Immobiliser System
05-1985
19. Theft Deterrent System
05-2012
20. Multiplex Communication System
05-2040
21. CAN Communication System
05-2090
22. Cruise Control System
05-2136
FOR USING OBD II SCAN TOOL OR HAND-HELD TESTER
Before using the scan tool or tester, the scan tool’s instruction book or tester’s operator manual should
be read thoroughly.
If the scan tool or tester cannot communicate with the ECU controlled systems when you have connected the cable of the tester to the DLC3 with the ignition switch and tester turned ON, there is a problem on the vehicle side or tester side.
(1) If communication is normal when the tester is connected to another vehicle, inspect the diagnosis
data link line (Busline) or ECU power circuit of the vehicle.
(2) If communication is still impossible when the tester is connected to another vehicle, the problem
is probably in the tester itself. So perform the Self Test procedures outlined in the Tester Operator’s Manual.
Author:
Date:
25
01-26
INTRODUCTION
-
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
010QM-01
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Carry out troubleshooting in accordance with the procedures below. Only a basic procedure is shown. Details in the Diagnostic Section show the most effective methods for each circuit. Confirm the troubleshooting
procedures for the relevant circuit before beginning troubleshooting.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
(a)
Ask the customer about the conditions and environment when the problem occurred.
3
(a)
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION AND DTC (AND FREEZE FRAME DATA) CHECK
Check the battery positive voltage.
Standard: 11 to 14 V (Engine stopped)
Visually check the wire harness, connectors and fuses for open and short, etc.
Warm up the engine to the normal operating temperature.
Confirm the problem symptoms and conditions, and check for DTCs according to the related chart.
(b)
(c)
(d)
OK
Go to step 5
NG
4
(a)
DTC CHART
Check the results obtained in step 3, then confirm the inspection procedures for the system or part
using the DTC chart.
Go to step 6
5
(a)
Check the results obtained in step 3. Confirm the inspection procedures for the system or part using
the problem symptoms table.
6
(a)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS CHART
CIRCUIT INSPECTION OR PARTS INSPECTION
Confirm the circuit in the system or the part that should be checked using the problem symptoms table
or the results obtained in step 4.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
26
INTRODUCTION
7
(a)
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
01-27
REPAIR
Repair the affected system or part according to the instructions in step 6.
8
(a)
-
CONFIRMATION TEST
After completing repairs, confirm that the problem has been solved. If the problem does not recur, perform a confirmation test under the same conditions and in the same environment as when it occurred
the first time.
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
27
01-28
INTRODUCTION
-
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
HINT:
In troubleshooting, the problem symptoms must be confirmed accurately. Preconceptions should be
discarded in order to give an accurate judgement. To clearly understand what the problem symptoms
are, it is extremely important to ask the customer about the problem and the conditions at the time it
occurred.
As much information as possible should be gathered for reference. Past problems that seem unrelated
may also help in some cases. In the Diagnostic section, a customer problem analysis table is provided
for each system.
5 items are important points in the problem analysis:
Important Points with Customer Problem Analysis
What ----- Vehicle model, system name
When ----- Date, time, occurrence frequency
Where ----- Road conditions
Under what conditions? ----- Running conditions, driving conditions, weather conditions
How did it happen? ----- Problem symptoms
(Sample) Supplemental Restraint System check sheet.
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
Inspector’s
Name
Supplemental Restraint System Check Sheet
VIN
Production Date
Customer’s Name
/
/
Licence Plate No.
Date Vehicle Brought In
/
km
miles
Odometer Reading
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Weather
Temperature
Vehicle Operation
/
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Snowy
/
Other
Approx.
Starting
Driving
[
Idling
Constant speed
Other
Acceleration
Deceleration
]
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
28
INTRODUCTION
-
01-29
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION AND DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
HINT:
The diagnostic system in the HIGHLANDER has various functions.
The first function is the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) check. A DTC is a code stored in the ECU
memory whenever a malfunction in the signal circuits to the ECU occurs. In a DTC check, a previous
malfunction’s DTC can be checked by a technician during troubleshooting.
Another function is the Input Signal Check, which checks if the signals from various switches are sent
to the ECU correctly.
By using these functions, the problem areas can be narrowed down and troubleshooting is more effective. Diagnostic functions are incorporated in the following systems in the HIGHLANDER:
System
SFI System
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check
Input Signal Check
(Sensor Check)
Diagnotis Test Mode
(Active Test)
(with Check Mode)
(with Check Mode)
ABS with EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC System
Electronic Controlled Automatic Transaxle [ECT]
Air Conditioning System
Supplement Restraint System
Power Window Control System
Power Door Lock Control System
Wireless Door Lock Control System
Engine Immobiliser System
Multiplex Communication System
Cruise Control System
In the DTC check, it is very important to determine whether the problem indicated by the DTC is: 1 still
occurring, or 2 occurred in the past but has since returned to normal. In addition, the DTC should be
compared to the problem symptom to see if they are related. For this reason, DTCs should be checked
before and after confirmation of symptoms (i.e., whether or not problem symptoms exist) to determine
current conditions, as shown in the table below.
Never skip the DTC check. Failure to check DTCs may, depending on the case, result in unnecessary
troubleshooting for systems operating normally or lead to repairs not pertinent to the problem. Follow
the procedures listed above in the correct order.
A flow chart showing how to proceed with troubleshooting using the DTC check is shown below. Directions from the flow chart will indicate should be performed DTC troubleshooting or to the troubleshooting of each problem symptom.
1
DTC CHECK
2
MAKE A NOTE OF DTCS DISPLAYED AND THEN CLEAR THE MEMORY
3
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
a
a
Symptoms exist
b
No symptoms exist
Go to step 5
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
29
01-30
INTRODUCTION
-
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
b
4
SIMULATION TEST USING THE SYMPTOM SIMULATION METHODS
5
DTC CHECK
a
a
DTC displayed
b
No DTC displayed
Troubleshooting of problem indicated by DTC
b
6
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
a
No symptoms exist
b
Symptoms exist
If a DTC was displayed in the initial DTC check, it indicates that
the trouble may have occurred in a wire harness or connector
in that circuit in the past. Check the wire harness and connectors (see page 01-36 ).
a
SYSTEM NORMAL
b
TROUBLESHOOTING OF EACH PROBLEM SYMPTOM
The problem is still occurring in a place other than the diagnostic circuit (the DTC displayed first is either for
a past problem or a secondary problem).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
30
INTRODUCTION
-
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
01-31
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
HINT:
The most difficult case in troubleshooting is when no problem symptoms occur. In such cases, a thorough
customer problem analysis must be carried out. A simulation of the same or similar conditions and environment in which the problem occurred in the customer’s vehicle should be carried out. No matter how much
skill or experience a technician has, troubleshooting without confirming the problem symptoms will lead to
important repairs being overlooked and mistakes or delays.
For example:
With a problem that only occurs when the engine is cold or occurs as a result of vibration caused by the road
during driving, the problem can never be determined if the symptoms are being checked on a stationary vehicle or a vehicle with a warmed-up engine.
Vibration, heat or water penetration (moisture) is difficult to reproduce. The symptom simulation tests below
are effective substitutes for the conditions and can be applied on a stationary vehicle.
Important points in the symptom simulation test:
In the symptom simulation test, the problem symptoms as well as the problem area or parts must be confirmed. First, narrow down the possible problem circuits according to the symptoms. Then, connect the tester
and carry out the symptom simulation test, judging whether the circuit being tested is defective or normal.
Also, confirm the problem symptoms at the same time. Refer to the problem symptoms table for each system
to narrow down the possible causes.
1.
VIBRATION METHOD: When vibration seems to be
Vibrate Slightly
the major cause.
(a) PART AND SENSOR
(1) Apply slight vibration with a finger to the part of the
sensor considered to be the cause of the problem
and check whether or not the malfunction occurs.
HINT:
Applying strong vibration to relays may open relays.
(b) CONNECTORS
(1) Slightly shake the connector vertically and horizontally.
(c) WIRE HARNESS
Shake Slightly
(1) Slightly shake the wire harness vertically and horizontally.
The connector joint and fulcrum of the vibration are
the major areas that should be checked thoroughly.
Vibrate
Slightly
B71602
2.
Malfunction
D25084
HEAT METHOD: If the problem seems to occur when
the area in question is heated.
(a) Heat the component that is the possible cause of the malfunction with a hair dryer or similar device. Check if the
malfunction occurs.
NOTICE:
Do not heat to more than 60C (140F). Exceeding this
temperature may damage components.
Do not apply heat directly to the parts in the ECU.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
31
01-32
INTRODUCTION
-
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
3.
D25085
WATER SPRINKLING METHOD: When the malfunction seems to occur on a rainy day or in highhumidity.
(a) Sprinkle water onto the vehicle and check if the malfunction occurs.
NOTICE:
Never sprinkle water directly into the engine compartment. Indirectly change the temperature and humidity by applying water spray onto the front of the radiator.
Never apply water directly onto electronic components.
HINT:
If the vehicle has or had a water leakage problem, the leakage
may have damaged the ECU or connections. Look for evidence
of corrosion or shorts. Proceed with caution during water tests.
4.
ON
(a)
HIGH ELECTRICAL LOAD METHOD: When a malfunction seems to occur when electrical load is excessive.
Turn on all the electrical loads including the heater blower,
headlights, rear window defogger, etc., and check if the
malfunction occurs.
B02389
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
32
INTRODUCTION
-
01-33
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Use Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) (from the DTC checks) in the table below to determine the trouble
area and proper inspection procedure. The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) diagnostic trouble code
chart is shown below as an example.
DTC No.
Indicates the diagnostic trouble code.
Page or Instructions
Indicates the page where the inspection procedures for each circuit is to be found, or gives
instructions for checking and repairs.
Trouble Area
Indicates the suspect areas of
the problem.
Detection Item
Indicates the system or details of the
problem.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit for that code listed in the table
below (Proceed to the page given for that circuit).
DTC No.
(See page)
Detection Item
Short in D squib circuit
B0100/13
(05-119)
Open in D squib circuit
B0101/14
(05-124)
Short in D squib circuit (to ground)
B0102/11
(05-128)
Short in D squib circuit (to B+)
B0103/12
(05-132)
B0105/53
(05-136)
Short in P squib circuit
B0106/54
Open in P squib circuit
SRS
Warning Light
Trouble Area
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Front passenger airbag assembly (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Front passenger airbag assembly (squib)
ON
ON
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Short in P squib circuit (to Ground)
Front passenger airbag assembly (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
33
01-34
INTRODUCTION
-
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
The suspected circuits or parts for each problem symptom are shown in the table below. Use this table to
troubleshoot when, during a DTC check, a ”Normal” code is displayed but the problem is still occurring. Numbers in the table show the inspection order in which the circuits or parts should be checked.
HINT:
In some cases, the problem is not detected by the diagnostic system even though a problem symptom is
present. It is possible that the problem is occurring outside the detection range of the diagnostic system, or
that the problem is occurring in a completely different system.
Page
Indicates the page where the flow chart for each circuit
is located.
Circuit Inspection, Inspection Order
Indicates the circuit which needs to be checked for each problem
symptom. Check in the order indicated by the numbers.
Problem Symptom
Circuit or Part Name
Indicates the circuit or part which needs to be checked.
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Inspect the ”Fuse” and ”Relay” before confirming the suspected area in the charts below (See page 68-1).
Symptom
See Page
Suspected Area
Black screen
1. Power source circuit (multi-display assy)
2. Multi-display
05-1267
67-7
Screen cannot be dimmer in night time
1. SRS warning light circuit (multi-display assy)
2. Multi-display assy
05-1277
67-7
A navigation system cannot be operated
1. Steering pad switch circuit
05-1183
2. AVC-LAN circuit (radio receiver assy-multidisplay assy)
05-1303
3. Radio receiver assy
67-5
4. Multi-display assy
67-7
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
34
INTRODUCTION
-
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
01-35
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
How to read and use each page is shown below.
Circuit Description
The major role, operation of the circuit and its
component parts are explained.
Diagnostic Trouble Code No. and Detection Item
Indicates the diagnostic trouble codes, diagnostic
trouble code settings and suspect areas for a
problem.
Inspection Procedures
Use the inspection procedures to determine
if the circuit is normal or abnormal. If it is abnormal, use it to determine whether the problem is located in the sensors, actuators, wire
harness or ECU.
SFI
SFI
Indicates the condition of the connector of the ECU
during the check.
Wiring Diagram
This shows a wiring diagram of the circuit.
Use this diagram together with ELECTRICAL
WIRING DIAGRAM to thoroughly understand the
circuit.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black, L = Blue, R = Red, BR = Brown,
LG = Light Green, V = Violet, G = Green,
O = Orange, W = White, GR = Gray, P = Pink,
Y = Yellow, SB = Sky Blue
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and
the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Connector being checked
is connected.
Connector being checked
is disconnected.
Connections of tester are
indicated by (+), (-) after
terminals name.
For inspection of connector
with body ground, there is
nothing about the body
ground written down.
D25842
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
35
01-41
INTRODUCTION
-
TERMS
TERMS
010QO-02
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN MANUAL
Abbreviations
Meaning
ABS
Anti-Lock Brake System
A/C
Air Conditioner
AC
Alternating Current
ACC
Accessory
ACIS
Acoustic Control Induction System
ACSD
Automatic Cold Start Device
A.D.D.
Automatic Disconnecting Differential
A/F
Air-Fuel Ratio
AHC
Active Height Control Suspension
ALR
Automatic Locking Retractor
ALT
Alternator
AMP
Amplifier
ANT
Antenna
Approx.
Approximately
ASSY
Assembly
A/T, ATM
Automatic Transmission
ATF
Automatic Transmission Fluid
AUTO
Automatic
AUX
Auxiliary
AVG
Average
AVS
Adaptive Variable Suspension
B+
Battery Voltage
BA
Brake Assist
BACS
Boost Altitude Compensation System
BAT
Battery
BDC
Bottom Dead Center
B/L
Bi-Level
B/S
Bore-Stroke Ratio
BTDC
Before Top Dead Center
BVSV
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve
CAN
Controller Area Network
CB
Circuit Breaker
CCo
Catalytic Converter For Oxidation
CD
Compact Disc
CF
Cornering Force
CG
Center Of Gravity
CH
Channel
CKD
Complete Knock Down
COMB.
Combination
CPE
Coupe
CPS
Combustion Pressure Sensor
CPU
Central Processing Unit
CRS
Child Restraint System
CTR
Center
C/V
Check Valve
CV
Control Valve
CW
Curb Weight
DC
Direct Current
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
41
01-42
INTRODUCTION
-
TERMS
Abbreviations
Meaning
DEF
Defogger
DFL
Deflector
DIFF.
Differential
DIFF. LOCK
Differential Lock
D/INJ
Direct Injection
DLC
Data Link Connector
DLI
Distributorless Ignition
DOHC
Double Overhead Camshaft
DP
Dash Pot
DS
Dead Soak
DSP
Digital Signal Processor
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code
DVD
Digital Versatile Disc
EBD
Electric Brake Force Distribution
ECAM
Engine Control And Measurement System
ECD
Electronic Controlled Diesel
ECDY
Eddy Current Dynamometer
ECT
Electronic Control Transmission
ECU
Electronic Control Unit
ED
Electro-Deposited Coating
EDU
Electronic Driving Unit
EDIC
Electric Diesel Injection Control
EFI
Electronic Fuel Injection
E/G
Engine
EGR
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
EGR-VM
EGR-V acuum Modulator
ELR
Emergency Locking Retractor
EMPS
Electric Motor Power Steering
ENG
Engine
ESA
Electronic Spark Advance
ETCS-i
Electronic Throttle Control System-intelligent
EVAP
Evaporative Emission Control
EVP
Evaporator
E-VR V
Electric Vacuum Regulating Valve
EX
Exhaust
FE
Fuel Economy
FF
Front-Engine Front-Wheel-Drive
F/G
Fuel Gauge
FIPG
Formed In Place Gasket
FL
Fusible Link
F/P
Fuel Pump
FPU
Fuel Pressure Up
Fr
Front
F/W
Flywheel
FW/D
Flywheel Damper
FWD
Front-Wheel-Drive
GAS
Gasoline
GND
Ground
GPS
Global Positioning System
HAC
High Altitude Compensator
H/B
Hatchback
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
42
01-43
INTRODUCTION
-
TERMS
Abbreviations
Meaning
H-FUSE
High Current Fuse
HI
High
HID
High Intensity Discharge (Head Lamp)
HSG
Housing
HT
Hard Top
HWS
Heated Windshield System
IC
Integrated Circuit
IDI
Indirect Diesel Injection
IFS
Independent Front Suspension
IG
Ignition
IIA
Integrated Ignition Assembly
IN
Intake (Manifold, Valve)
INT
Intermittent
I/P
Instrument Panel
IRS
Independent Rear Suspension
ISC
Idle Speed Control
J/B
Junction Block
J/C
Junction Connector
KD
Kick-Down
LAN
Local Area Network
LB
Liftback
LCD
Liquid Crystal Display
LED
Light Emitting Diode
LH
Left-Hand
LHD
Left-Hand Drive
L/H/W
Length, Height, Width
LLC
Long-Life Coolant
LNG
Liquified Natural Gas
LO
Low
LPG
Liquified Petroleum Gas
LSD
Limited Slip Differential
LSP & PV
Load Sensing Proportioning And Bypass Valve
LSPV
Load Sensing Proportioning Valve
MAP
Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX.
Maximum
MIC
Microphone
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
MIN.
Minimum
MG1
Motor Generator No.1
MG2
Motor Generator No.2
MP
Multipurpose
MPI
Multipoint Electronic Injection
MPX
Multiplex Communication System
M/T, MTM
Manual Transmission (Transaxle)
MT
Mount
MTG
Mounting
N
Neutral
NA
Natural Aspiration
No.
Number
O2S
Oxygen Sensor
O/D
Overdrive
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
43
01-44
INTRODUCTION
-
TERMS
Abbreviations
Meaning
OEM
Original Equipment Manufacturing
OHC
Overhead Camshaft
OHV
Overhead Valve
OPT
Option
ORVR
On-board Refilling Vapor Recovery
O/S
Oversize
P & BV
Proportioning And Bypass Valve
PCS
Power Control System
PCV
Positive Crankcase Ventilation
PKB
Parking Brake
PPS
Progressive Power Steering
PTC
Positive Temperature Coefficient
PS
Power Steering
PTO
Power Take-Of f
P/W
Power Window
R&P
Rack And Pinion
RAM
Random Access Memory
R/B
Relay Block
RBS
Recirculating Ball Type Steering
R/F
Reinforcement
RFS
Rigid Front Suspension
RH
Right-Hand
RHD
Right-Hand Drive
RLY
Relay
ROM
Read Only Memory
Rr
Rear
RRS
Rigid Rear Suspension
RWD
Rear-Wheel Drive
SDN
Sedan
SEN
Sensor
SICS
Starting Injection Control System
SOC
State Of Charge
SOHC
Single Overhead Camshaft
SPEC
Specification
SPI
Single Point Injection
SRS
Supplemental Restraint System
SSM
Special Service Materials
SST
Special Service Tools
STD
Standard
STJ
Cold-Start Fuel Injection
SW
Switch
SYS
System
T/A
Transaxle
TACH
Tachometer
TBI
Throttle Body Electronic Fuel Injection
TC
Turbocharger
TCCS
TOYOTA Computer-Controlled System
TCV
Timing Control Valve
TDC
Top Dead Center
TEMP.
Temperature
TEMS
TOYOTA Electronic Modulated Suspension
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
44
01-45
INTRODUCTION
-
TERMS
Abbreviations
Meaning
TFT
TOYOTA Free-Tronic
TIS
Total Information System For Vehicle Development
T/M
Transmission
TMC
TOYOTA Motor Corporation
TMMK
TOYOTA Motor Manufacturing Kentucky, Inc.
TRAC
Traction Control System
TURBO
Turbocharge
TWC
Three-W ay Catalyst
U/D
Underdrive
U/S
Undersize
VCV
Vacuum Control Valve
VENT
Ventilator
VIN
Vehicle Identification Number
VPS
Variable Power Steering
VSC
Vehicle Stability Control
VSV
Vacuum Switching Valve
VTV
Vacuum Transmitting Valve
VVT-i
Variable Valve Timing-intelligent
w/
With
WGN
Wagon
W/H
Wire Harness
w/o
Without
WU-TWC
Warm Up Three-way Catalytic Converter
WU-OC
Warm Up Oxidation Catalytic Converter
1st
First
2nd
Second
2WD
Two Wheel Drive Vehicle (4 x 2)
3rd
Third
4th
Fourth
4WD
Four Wheel Drive Vehicle (4 x 4)
4WS
Four Wheel Steering System
5th
Fifth
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
45
01-46
INTRODUCTION
-
TERMS
010QP-01
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
This glossary lists all SAE-J1930 terms and abbreviations used in this manual in compliance with SAE recommendations, as well as their TOYOTA equivalents.
SAE
ABBREVIATIONS
TOYOTA TERMS
( )--ABBREVIATIONS
SAE TERMS
A/C
Air Conditioning
Air Conditioner
ACL
Air Cleaner
Air Cleaner, A/CL
AIR
Secondary Air Injection
Air Injection (AI)
AP
Accelerator Pedal
B+
Battery Positive Voltage
+B, Battery Voltage
BARO
Barometric Pressure
HAC
CAC
Charge Air Cooler
Intercooler
CARB
Carburetor
Carburetor
CFI
Continuous Fuel Injection
CKP
Crankshaft Position
Crank Angle
CL
Closed Loop
Closed Loop
CMP
Camshaft Position
Cam Angle
CPP
Clutch Pedal Position
-
CTOX
Continuous Trap Oxidizer
-
CTP
Closed Throttle Position
LL ON, Idle ON
DFI
Direct Fuel Injection
Direct Injection (DI/INJ)
DI
Distributor Ignition
DLC1
DLC2
DLC3
Data Link Connector 1
Data Link Connector 2
Data Link Connector 3
1: Check Connector
2: Total Diagnosis Communication Link (TDCL)
3: OBD II Diagnostic Connector
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Diagnostic Trouble Code
DTM
Diagnostic Test Mode
-
ECL
Engine Coolant Level
-
ECM
Engine Control Module
Engine ECU (Electronic Control Unit)
ECT
Engine Coolant Temperature
Coolant Temperature, Water Temperature (THW)
EEPROM
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EEPROM),
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EPROM)
EFE
Early Fuel Evaporation
Cold Mixture Heater (CMH), Heat Control Valve (HCV)
EGR
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
EI
Electronic Ignition
Distributorless Ignition (DLI)
EM
Engine Modification
Engine Modification (EM)
EPROM
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Programmable Read Only Memory (PROM)
EVAP
Evaporative Emission
Evaporative Emission Control (EVAP)
FC
Fan Control
-
FEEPROM
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable
Read Only Memory
-
FEPROM
Flash Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
-
FF
Flexible Fuel
-
FP
Fuel Pump
Fuel Pump
GEN
Generator
Alternator
GND
Ground
Ground (GND)
-
-
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
46
01-47
INTRODUCTION
-
TERMS
HO2S
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
IAC
Idle Air Control
Idle Speed Control (ISC)
IAT
Intake Air Temperature
Intake or Inlet Air Temperature
ICM
Ignition Control Module
IFI
Indirect Fuel Injection
IFS
Inertia Fuel-Shutoff
-
ISC
Idle Speed Control
-
KS
Knock Sensor
Knock Sensor
MAF
Mass Airflow
Air Flow Meter
MAP
Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure Intake Vacuum
MC
Mixture Control
Electric Bleed Air Control Valve (EBCV)
Mixture Control Valve (MCV)
Electric Air Control Valve (EACV)
MDP
Manifold Differential Pressure
MFI
Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI)
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Check Engine Lamp
MST
Manifold Surface Temperature
-
MVZ
Manifold Vacuum Zone
-
NVRAM
Non-V olatile Random Access Memory
-
O2S
Oxygen Sensor
Oxygen Sensor, O2 Sensor (O2S)
OBD
On-Board Diagnostic
On-Board Diagnostic System (OBD)
OC
Oxidation Catalytic Converter
Oxidation Catalyst Convert (OC), CCo
OL
Open Loop
Open Loop
PAIR
Pulsed Secondary Air Injection
Air Suction (AS)
PCM
Powertrain Control Module
-
PNP
Park/Neutral Position
-
PROM
Programmable Read Only Memory
-
PSP
Power Steering Pressure
-
PTOX
Periodic Trap Oxidizer
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
Diesel Particulate Trap (DPT)
RAM
Random Access Memory
Random Access Memory (RAM)
RM
Relay Module
ROM
Read Only Memory
Read Only Memory (ROM)
RPM
Engine Speed
Engine Speed
SC
Supercharger
Supercharger
SCB
Supercharger Bypass
E-ABV
SFI
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI), Sequential Injection
SPL
Smoke Puff Limiter
-
SRI
Service Reminder Indicator
-
SRT
System Readiness Test
-
ST
Scan Tool
-
TB
Throttle Body
Throttle Body
TBI
Throttle Body Fuel Injection
Single Point Injection
Central Fuel Injection (Ci)
TC
Turbocharger
Turbocharger
TCC
Torque Converter Clutch
Torque Converter
Indirect Injection (IDL)
-
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
47
01-48
INTRODUCTION
-
TERMS
TCM
Transmission Control Module
Transmission ECU, ECT ECU
TP
Throttle Position
Throttle Position
TR
Transmission Range
TVV
Thermal Vacuum Valve
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve (BVSV)
Thermostatic Vacuum Switching Valve (TVSV)
TWC
Three-W ay Catalytic Converter
Three-W ay Catalytic (TWC)
Manifold Converter
CCRO
TWC+OC
Three-W ay + Oxidation Catalytic Converter
CCR + CCo
VAF
Volume Airflow
Air Flow Meter
VR
Voltage Regulator
Voltage Regulator
VSS
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor
WOT
Wide Open Throttle
Full Throttle
WU-OC
Warm Up Oxidation Catalytic Converter
-
WU-TWC
Warm Up Three-Way Catalytic Converter
-
3GR
Third Gear
-
4GR
Fourth Gear
-
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
48
02-60
PREPARATION
-
SEAT BELT
SEAT BELT
020XO-03
PREPARATION
SST
09082-00700
SRS Airbag Deployment Tool
FRONT SEAT BELT
09082-00770
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub-harness No.5
FRONT SEAT BELT
Equipment
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
108
02-67
PREPARATION
-
SEAT
SEAT
023H3-02
PREPARATION
Recomended Tools
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (POWER
SEAT TYPE)
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (MANUAL
SEAT TYPE)
09042-00020
Torx Socket T40
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH(W/O
REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH(W/O
REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH(W/REAR
NO.2 SEAT)
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH(W/REAR
NO.2 SEAT)
09042-00050
Torx Socket T45
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH(W/O
REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH(W/REAR
NO.2 SEAT)
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH(W/REAR
NO.2 SEAT)
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL
SYSTEM
SEAT HEATER SYSTEM
09200-00010
Engine Adjust Kit
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (POWER
SEAT TYPE)
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (MANUAL
SEAT TYPE)
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Equipment
Hog ring
Hog ring pliers
Tape
To avoid surface damage
Torque wrench
Torx socket wrench (T55)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
115
02-7
PREPARATION
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE MECHANICAL
023HH-01
PREPARATION
SST
09011-38121
12 mm Socket Wrench for 12
Pointed Head
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09032-00100
Oil Pan Seal Cutter
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09201-01055
Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer 5.5
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09201-10000
Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer Set
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09201-01050)
Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer 5
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(2AZ-FE)
09201-41020
Valve Stem Oil Seal Replacer
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09202-70020
Valve Spring Compressor
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(3MZ-FE)
Attachment
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(3MZ-FE)
Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(2AZ-FE)
CHAIN(2AZ-FE)
(09202-00010)
09213-54015
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
55
02-8
PREPARATION
(91651-60855)
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Bolt
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(2AZ-FE)
CHAIN(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09222-30010
Connecting Rod Bushing Remover
& Replacer
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09223-00010
Cover & Seal Replacer
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09223-15030
Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09223-22010
Crankshaft Front Oil Seal
Replacer
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING
CHAIN CASE OIL SEAL(2AZ-FE)
09228-06501
Oil Filter Wrench
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
09228-07501
Oil Filter Wrench
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09248-55040
Valve Clearance Adjust Tool Set
VALVE CLEARANCE(3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
(09248-05410)
Valve Lifter Press
VALVE CLEARANCE(3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
(09248-05420)
Valve Lifter Stopper
VALVE CLEARANCE(3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
09249-63010
Torque Wrench Adaptor
FAN
AND
GENERATOR
V
BELT(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
GASKET
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
56
02-9
PREPARATION
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
09308-10010
Oil Seal Puller
TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING
CHAIN CASE OIL SEAL(2AZ-FE)
09309-37010
Transmission Bearing Replacer
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CHAIN(2AZ-FE)
09325-20010
Transmission Oil Plug
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09330-00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(2AZ-FE)
CHAIN(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09520-01010
Drive Shaft Remover Attachment
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09520-24010
Differential Side Gear Shaft
Puller
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
Shocker Set
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09628-6201 1
Boll Joint Puller
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09843-18020
Diagnosis Check Wire
ENGINE(2AZ-FE)
09843-18030
Tacho-pulse Pickup Wire No.2
ENGINE(2AZ-FE)
FAN
AND
GENERATOR
BELT(2AZ-FE)
(09520-32040)
V
ENGINE(3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
57
02-10
PREPARATION
09843-18040
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Diagnosis Check Wire No.2
ENGINE(2AZ-FE)
ENGINE(3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09930-00010
Drive Shaft Nut Chisel
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09950-50013
Puller C Set
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CHAIN(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CHAIN(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CHAIN(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CHAIN(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
(09954-0501 1)
Claw No.1
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
(09954-05021)
Claw No.2
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CHAIN(2AZ-FE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
58
02-1 1
PREPARATION
(09954-05031)
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Claw No.3
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09950-60010
Replacer Set
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(2AZ-FE)
TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING
CHAIN CASE OIL SEAL(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09951-00200)
Replacer 20
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(2AZ-FE)
TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING
CHAIN CASE OIL SEAL(2AZ-FE)
(09951-00430)
Replacer 43
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09950-70010
Handle Set
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(2AZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(2AZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09960-10010
Variable Pin Wrench Set
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
(09962-01000)
Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assy
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
(09963-00500)
Pin 5
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
59
02-12
PREPARATION
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(09963-00700)
Pin 7
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
(09963-01000)
Pin 10
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09992-00500
Compression Gauge Attachment
ENGINE(3MZ-FE)
09011-12301
Socket Wrench 30 mm
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09031-00040
Pin Punch .
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(2AZ-FE)
09040-0001 1
Hexagon Wrench Set
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
VALVE CLEARANCE(3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
Recomended Tools
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09043-20050)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 5
VALVE CLEARANCE(3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
(09043-20080)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 8
VALVE CLEARANCE(3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
60
02-13
PREPARATION
(09043-20100)
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Socket Hexagon Wrench 10
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09043-20120)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 12
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09043-30140)
Straight Hexagon Wrench 14
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
(09043-20080)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 8
VALVE CLEARANCE(3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
(09043-20100)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 10
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09043-50100
Bi-hexagon Wrench 10 mm
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(2AZ-FE)
09090-04020
Engine Sling Device
CHAIN(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09200-00010
Engine Adjust Kit
VALVE CLEARANCE(3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09216-00021
Belt Tension Gauge
ENGINE(3MZ-FE)
DRIVE BELT(3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
09904-00010
(09904-00040)
Expander Set
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
No. 3 Claw
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
61
02-14
PREPARATION
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Equipment
Abrasive compound
Valve
Brush
Piston
Caliper gauge
Carbide cutter
CO/HC meter
Compression gauge
Connecting rod aligner
Cylinder gauge
Dial indicator
Dye penetrant
Engine tune-up tester
Groove cleaning tool
Piston ring groove
Heater
Hexagon wrench (1.5 mm)
Timing belt tensioner
Micrometer
Pin hole grinder
Connecting rod bushing
Piston ring compressor
Piston ring expander
Plastigage
Precision straight edge
Press
Reamer
Cylinder
Ridge reamer
Cylinder
Soft brush
Cylinder head
Cylinder block
Solvent
Spring tester
Valve spring
Steel square
Valve spring
Thermometer
Torque wrench
Valve seat cutter
Valve guide bushing brush
V-block
Vernier calipers
Wire brush
Valve
Cylinder head
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
62
02-15
PREPARATION
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSM
08826-00080
Seal Packing Black or equivalent
(FIPG)
VALVE CLEARANCE(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(2AZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT(2AZ-FE)
CHAIN(2AZ-FE)
VALVE CLEARANCE(3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK)(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER
HEAD
GASKET
NO.2(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(3MZ-FE)
08826-00100
”Seal Packing 1282B,”
THREE BOND 1282B or equivalent
(FIPG)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(3MZ-FE)
08833-00070
”Adhesive 1324,”
THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY(3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY(3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY(3MZ-FE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
63
02-3
PREPARATION
-
FUEL
FUEL
023HA-01
PREPARATION
SST
Injection Measuring Tool Set
FUEL SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
FUEL SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
(09268-41 110)
Adaptor
FUEL SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
FUEL SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
(09268-41300)
Clamp
FUEL SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
FUEL SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
(95336-08070)
Hose
FUEL SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
FUEL SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
Retainer Tool,Fuel Pump
FUEL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
FUEL TANK ASSY(2AZ-FE)
FUEL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09268-41047
09808-14020
FUEL TANK ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09808-01410)
Holder
FUEL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
FUEL TANK ASSY(2AZ-FE)
FUEL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
FUEL TANK ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09808-01420)
Claw
FUEL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
FUEL TANK ASSY(2AZ-FE)
FUEL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
FUEL TANK ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09808-01430)
Bolt
FUEL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
FUEL TANK ASSY(2AZ-FE)
FUEL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
FUEL TANK ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09842-30070
Wire ”F” EFI Inspection
FUEL SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
09842-30080
Wire ”H” EFI Inspection
FUEL SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
FUEL SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
Test Lead Set
FUEL SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
FUEL SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
Recomended Tools
(09083-00150)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
51
02-4
PREPARATION
-
FUEL
Equipment
Clip
Measuring Flask
Radiator cap tester
Stopwatch
Torque wrench
Vernier calipers
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
52
02-55
PREPARATION
-
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
023HI-01
PREPARATION
SST
07110-58060
Air Conditioner Service Tool Set
REFRIGERANT
AIR CONDITIONING
ASSY
RADIATOR
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
COOLER
COMPRESSOR
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(07117-58060)
Refrigerant Drain Service Valve
COMPRESSOR
REFRIGERANT
AIR CONDITIONING
ASSY
RADIATOR
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
COOLER
COMPRESSOR
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(07117-58070)
T-Joint
COMPRESSOR
REFRIGERANT
AIR CONDITIONING
ASSY
RADIATOR
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
COOLER
COMPRESSOR
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(07117-58080)
Quick Disconnect Adapter
COMPRESSOR
REFRIGERANT
AIR CONDITIONING
ASSY
RADIATOR
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
COOLER
COMPRESSOR
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(07117-58090)
Quick Disconnect Adapter
COMPRESSOR
REFRIGERANT
AIR CONDITIONING
ASSY
RADIATOR
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
COOLER
COMPRESSOR
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(07117-78050)
Refrigerant Charging Gauge
COMPRESSOR
REFRIGERANT
AIR CONDITIONING
ASSY
RADIATOR
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
COOLER
COMPRESSOR
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
COMPRESSOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
103
02-56
PREPARATION
(07117-88060)
-
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
Refrigerant Charging Hose
REFRIGERANT
AIR CONDITIONING
ASSY
RADIATOR
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
COOLER
COMPRESSOR
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(07117-88070)
Refrigerant Charging Hose
COMPRESSOR
REFRIGERANT
AIR CONDITIONING
ASSY
RADIATOR
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
COOLER
COMPRESSOR
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(07117-88080)
Refrigerant Charging Hose
COMPRESSOR
REFRIGERANT
AIR CONDITIONING
ASSY
RADIATOR
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
COOLER
COMPRESSOR
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
07117-48130
Vacuum Pump (220 V)
REFRIGERANT
COOLER
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
07117-48140
Vacuum Pump (240 V)
REFRIGERANT
COOLER
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
COMPRESSOR
COMPRESSOR
COMPRESSOR
COMPRESSOR
COMPRESSOR
09870-00015
A/C Quick Joint Puller No.1
AIR CONDITIONING
ASSY
RADIATOR
09870-00025
A/C Quick Joint Puller No.2
AIR CONDITIONING
ASSY
RADIATOR
95047-10400
Magnet Clutch Stopper
(DENSO part No.)
COOLER
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
COMPRESSOR
COMPRESSOR
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
104
02-57
PREPARATION
-
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
Recomended Tools
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
AIRCONDITIONER
ASSY
09904-00010
Expander Set
COOLER
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
AMPLIFIER
COMPRESSOR
COMPRESSOR
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09904-00050)
No. 4 Claw
COOLER
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
COOLER
COMPRESSOR
COMPRESSOR
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
EQUIPMENT
Voltmeter
Anmeter
Ohmmeter
Vinyl tape
Belt tension gauge
Hexagon wrench 10 mm (0.39 in.)
Hexagon wrench 4 mm (0.16 in.)
Torque socket wrench (E 8)
Gas leak detector
Dial indicator
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
105
02-5
PREPARATION
-
EMISSION CONTROL
EMISSION CONTROL
023H6-01
PREPARATION
Recomended Tools
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
EMISSION
TEM(2AZ-FE)
EMISSION
CONTROL
SYS-
CONTROL
SYS-
CONTROL
SYS-
CONTROL
SYS-
VALVE
SUB-
VALVE
SUB-
TEM(3MZ-FE)
(09083-00150)
Test Lead Set
EMISSION
TEM(2AZ-FE)
EMISSION
TEM(3MZ-FE)
Equipment
Hand-held vacuum pump
Ohmmeter
Service Wire Harness
Torque wrench
Vacuum gauge
Pressure gauge
Vernier caliper
SSM
08833-00070
”Adhesive 1324,”
THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
VENTILATION
ASSY(2AZ-FE)
VENTILATION
ASSY(3MZ-FE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
53
02-22
PREPARATION
-
STARTING & CHARGING
STARTING & CHARGING
023HC-01
PREPARATION
SST
09820-00021
Alternator Rear Bearing Puller
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09820-00031
Alternator Rotor Rear Bearing
Replacer
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09820-63010
Alternator Pulley Set Nut Wrench
Set
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09820-06010)
Alternator Rotor Shaft Wrench
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09820-06020)
Alternator Pulley Set Nut 22 mm
Wrench
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09950-4001 1
Puller B Set
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09951-04020)
Hanger 200
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09953-04020)
Center Bolt 150
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09954-04010)
Arm 25
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09955-04071)
Claw No.7
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09957-04010)
Attachment
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
70
02-23
PREPARATION
-
STARTING & CHARGING
Holder
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09950-60010
Replacer Set
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09951-00250)
Replacer 25
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09951-00470)
Replacer 47
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09950-70010
Handle Set
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
STARTER ASSY(3MZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
Test Lead Set
STARTER ASSY(2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
STARTING SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
(09958-0401 1)
Recomended Tools
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
STARTER ASSY(3MZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09904-00010
(09904-00050)
Expander Set
STARTER ASSY(2AZ-FE)
STARTER ASSY(3MZ-FE)
No. 4 Claw
STARTER ASSY(2AZ-FE)
STARTER ASSY(3MZ-FE)
Equipment
Ammeter
Voltmeter
Dial indicator
Ohmmeter
Sandpaper (#400)
Service Wire Harness
Torque wrench
Vernier caliper
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
71
02-71
PREPARATION
-
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
023H5-01
PREPARATION
Recomended Tools
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
ASSY LH
REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING
ASSY LH
ROOF
DRIP
SIDE
MOULDING CENTER LH
FINISH
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
Equipment
Adhesive tape
To avoid surface damage.
Clip remover
Knife
Protective tape
To avoid surface damage.
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
119
02-65
PREPARATION
-
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR
020XQ-03
PREPARATION
Recomended Tools
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
BACK DOOR GLASS
09082-00050
TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
POWER
SYSTEM
MIRROR
CONTROL
Test Lead Set
POWER
SYSTEM
POWER
WINDOW
CONTROL
MIRROR
CONTROL
(09083-00150)
SYSTEM
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
Equipment
Knife
Piano wire
Windshield
Plastic sheet
To avoid surface damage
Sealer gun
Tape
To avoid surface damage
Torque wrench
Wooden block or similar object
For tying both piano wire ends
SSM
08833-00030
Three cement black or equivalent
WINDSHIELD GLASS
BACK DOOR GLASS
QUARTER WINDOW ASSY LH
08850-00801
Windshield Glass Adhesive Set
or equivalent
WINDSHIELD GLASS
BACK DOOR GLASS
QUARTER WINDOW ASSY LH
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
113
02-70
PREPARATION
-
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
023BO-02
PREPARATION
SST
09812-00010
Door Hinge Set Bolt Wrench
FRONT DOOR
09041-00020
Torx Driver T25
FRONT DOOR
REAR DOOR
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
FRONT DOOR
REAR DOOR
09042-00020
Torx Socket T40
FRONT DOOR
REAR DOOR
BACK DOOR
Recomended Tools
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
SSM
08833-00070
”Adhesive 1324,”
THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
FRONT DOOR
REAR DOOR
Equipment
Clip remover
Tape
To avoid surface damage
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
118
02-2
PREPARATION
-
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
023H9-01
PREPARATION
Recomended Tools
Hexagon Wrench Set
THROTTLE BODY ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09043-20050)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 5
THROTTLE BODY ASSY(3MZ-FE)
KNOCK SENSOR(3MZ-FE)
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
SFI SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
Test Lead Set
SFI SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
SFI SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
09040-0001 1
(09083-00150)
Equipment
Ohmmeter
Radiator cap tester
Service Wire Harness
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
50
02-16
PREPARATION
-
EXHAUST
EXHAUST
023H8-01
PREPARATION
Equipment
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
64
02-17
PREPARATION
-
COOLING
COOLING
023HF-01
PREPARATION
SST
Radiator Service Tool Set
RADIATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
RADIATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09231-01010)
Overhaul Handle
RADIATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
RADIATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09231-01030)
Claw
RADIATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
RADIATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09231-14010
Punch
RADIATOR ASSY(2AZ-FE)
RADIATOR ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09960-10010
Variable Pin Wrench Set
WATER PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
(09962-01000)
Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assy
WATER PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
(09963-00700)
Pin 7
WATER PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
09082-00050
TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set
COOLING FAN SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
COOLING FAN SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
08826-00080
Seal Packing Black or equivalent
(FIPG)
WATER PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
WATER PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09230-01010
Recomended Tools
Equipment
Ohmmeter
Radiator cap tester
Thermomete
Torque wrench
Slide calipers
Heater
SSM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
65
02-18
PREPARATION
-
LUBRICATION
LUBRICATION
023H1-02
PREPARATION
SST
09032-00100
Oil Pan Seal Cutter
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09213-54015
Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
Bolt
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09223-00010
Cover & Seal Replacer
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09228-06501
Oil Filter Wrench
OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY(2AZ-FE)
09228-07501
Oil Filter Wrench
OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09249-63010
Torque Wrench Adaptor
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09309-37010
Transmission Bearing Replacer
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
09330-00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09950-50013
Puller C Set
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(91651-60855)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
66
02-19
PREPARATION
-
LUBRICATION
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09954-0501 1)
Claw No.1
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09954-05021)
Claw No.2
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
(09954-05031)
Claw No.3
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
Variable Pin Wrench Set
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09962-01000)
Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assy
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09963-01000)
Pin 10
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
Hexagon Wrench Set
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 10
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09090-04020
Engine Sling Device
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
09200-00010
Engine Adjust Kit
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
OIL PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09960-10010
Equipment
Feeler gauge
Precision straight edge
Radiator cap tester
Torque wrench
Recomended Tools
09040-0001 1
(09043-20100)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
67
02-20
PREPARATION
-
LUBRICATION
SSM
08826-00080
Seal Packing Black or equivalent
(FIPG)
OIL PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
68
02-21
PREPARATION
-
IGNITION
IGNITION
023HB-01
PREPARATION
Recomended Tools
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
09200-00010
(09857-00031)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
IGNITION SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
IGNITION SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
Test Lead Set
IGNITION SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
IGNITION SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
Engine Adjust Kit
IGNITION SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
IGNITION SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
Spark Plug Gap Gauge
IGNITION SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
IGNITION SYSTEM(3MZ-FE)
Equipment
megaohmmeter
Spark plug llener
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
69
02-1
PREPARATION
-
DIAGNOSTICS
DIAGNOSTICS
020YV-02
PREPARATION
SST
09816-30010
Oil Pressure Switch Socket
SFI SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
09843-18040
Diagnosis Check Wire No.2
ABS WITH BA & EBD SYSTEM
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC
SYSTEM
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMBINATION METER
SFI SYSTEM(1MZ-FE)
SUPPLEMENTAL
SYSTEM
RESTRAINT
Recomended Tools
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
SFI SYSTEM(1MZ-FE)
SFI SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
Test Lead Set
AUDIO SYSTEM
ABS WITH BA & EBD SYSTEM
ELECTRONIC
CONTROLLED
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE[ECT]
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC
SYSTEM
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMBINATION METER
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM
BODY
MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
POWER
WINDOW
SYSTEM
SFI SYSTEM(1MZ-FE)
CONTROL
SUPPLEMENTAL
RESTRAINT
SYSTEM
SFI SYSTEM(2AZ-FE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
49
02-37
PREPARATION
-
TRANSFER
TRANSFER
023G9-01
PREPARATION
SST
09223-00010
Cover & Seal Replacer
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09223-4601 1
Crankshaft Front Oil Seal
Replacer
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09308-00010
Oil Seal Puller
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09316-00021)
Replacer ”A”
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09316-00041)
Replacer ”C”
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09316-00061)
Replacer ”E”
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09326-2001 1
Output Shaft Bearing Lock Nut
Wrench
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09387-00010
Transfer Oil Seal Replacer
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09387-00090
Senter Differential
Sentering Tool
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09506-35010
Differential Drive Pinion Rear
Bearing Replacer
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09520-01010
Drive Shaft Remover Attachment
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL(4WD)
09316-6001 1
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
85
02-38
PREPARATION
-
TRANSFER
09520-10021
Drive Shaft Remover & Replacer
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09520-24010
Differential Side Gear Shaft
Puller
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL(4WD)
Shocker Set
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL(4WD)
Differential Side Bearing
Replacer
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
(09951-00380)
Replacer 38
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00580)
Replacer 58
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09952-06010)
Adapter
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
Differential Drive Pinion
Holding Tool 28
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
Steering Pinion Bearing Replacer
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09628-6201 1
Boll Joint Puller
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL(4WD)
09930-00010
Drive Shaft Nut Chisel
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09950-00020
Bearing Remover
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09950-00030
Bearing Remover Attachment
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09520-32040)
09550-60010
09556-16030
(09612-10061)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
86
02-39
PREPARATION
-
TRANSFER
09950-4001 1
Puller B Set
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-04010)
Hanger 150
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09953-04020)
Center Bolt 150
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09954-04010)
Arm 25
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09955-04061)
Claw No.6
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09957-04010)
Attachment
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09958-0401 1)
Holder
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09950-60010
Replacer Set
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00350)
Replacer 35
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00360)
Replacer 36
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00380)
Replacer 38
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00420)
Replacer 42
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
87
02-40
PREPARATION
-
TRANSFER
(09951-00430)
Replacer 43
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00560)
Replacer 56
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00580)
Replacer 58
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00610)
Replacer 61
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00620)
Replacer 62
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09952-06010)
Adapter
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
Replacer Set No.2
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00710)
Replacer 71
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00750)
Replacer 75
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00770)
Replacer 77
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-00810)
Replacer 81
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09950-70010
Handle Set
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
09950-60020
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09951-07150)
Handle 150
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
88
02-41
PREPARATION
-
TRANSFER
Handle 200
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09011-12301
Socket Wrench 30 mm
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL(4WD)
09040-0001 1
Hexagon Wrench Set
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
(09951-07200)
Recomended Tools
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
TYPE T OIL SEAL(4WD)
09090-04020
Engine Sling Device
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
09904-00010
Expander Set
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
No. 1 Claw
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL(4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
Snap Ring Pliers
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
Claw Set
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
”Seal Packing 1281,”
THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
(FIPG)
TRANSFER ASSY(4WD)
(09904-00020)
09905-00013
(09904-00090)
SSM
08826-00090
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
89
02-42
PREPARATION
-
TRANSFER
Equipment
Torque wrench
Dial gauge with magnetic base
Transfer assy(4WD)
V-block
Transfer assy(4WD)
Hexagon wrench (6 mm)
Lubricant
Item
Transfer oil
Capacity
Classification
0.9 litters (0.95 US qts, 0.71 lmp.qts)
Hypoid gear oil SAE 90 (GL-5)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
90
02-63
PREPARATION
-
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
020VI-03
PREPARATION
SST
09950-50013
Puller C Set
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.2
NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSY
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.2
NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSY
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.2
NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSY
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.2
NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSY
(09954-05021)
Claw No.2
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.2
NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSY
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.2
STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSY
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
AMPLIFIER ANTENNA ASSY
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.3
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.2
Recomended Tools
POWER OUTLET SOCKET ASSY
VOLTAGE INVERTER ASSY
VIDEO(VIDEO
ADAPTER)
TERMINAL
RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
MULTI-DISPLA Y (CRT DISPLAY)
DISPLAY
AMPLIFIER ANTENNA ASSY
NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSY
CIGARETTE LIGHTER ASSY
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Equipment
Clip remover
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
111
02-66
PREPARATION
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
020WE-04
PREPARATION
SST
09950-50013
Puller C Set
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
SUB-ASSY
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
SUB-ASSY
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
SUB-ASSY
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
SUB-ASSY
(09954-05021)
Claw No.2
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
SUB-ASSY
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
SUB-ASSY
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
SUB-ASSY
COMBINATION METER ASSY
Recomended Tools
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Equipment
Torque wrench
Tape
To avoid surface damage
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
114
02-46
PREPARATION
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
023B6-02
PREPARATION
SST
09023-12701
Union Nut Wrench 17 mm
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U151E/U151F)
AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
09223-15020
Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151E)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
OIL
OIL
SEAL(U151F)
09249-63010
Torque Wrench Adaptor
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
TRANSAXLE
09308-00010
Oil Seal Puller
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U140F)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151E)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151F)
OIL
OIL
OIL
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U241E)
OIL
09309-37010
Transmission Bearing Replacer
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U140F)
OIL
09316-6001 1
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151E)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
OIL
OIL
SEAL(U241E)
(09316-0001 1)
Replacer Pipe
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151E)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
OIL
OIL
SEAL(U241E)
09325-20010
Transmission Oil Plug
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
09350-32014
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
AND DRIVE PLATE(ATM)
AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE
ASSY(U151E/U151F)
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
(09351-32010)
One-way Clutch Test Tool
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
AND DRIVE PLATE(ATM)
AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE
ASSY(U151E/U151F)
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
TRANSAXLE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
94
02-47
PREPARATION
(09351-32020)
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
Stator Stopper
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
AND DRIVE PLATE(ATM)
AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE
ASSY(U151E/U151F)
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
09520-01010
Drive Shaft Remover Attachment
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151E)
TRANSMISSION
VALVE
ASSY(U151E/U151F)
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U151E/U151F)
09520-24010
Differential Side Gear Shaft
Puller
Shocker Set
OIL
BODY
TRANSAXLE
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151F)
OIL
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151E)
TRANSMISSION
VALVE
OIL
ASSY(U151E/U151F)
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U151E/U151F)
(09520-32040)
TRANSAXLE
BODY
TRANSAXLE
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151F)
OIL
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151E)
TRANSMISSION
VALVE
OIL
ASSY(U151E/U151F)
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U151E/U151F)
BODY
TRANSAXLE
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151F)
09628-6201 1
Boll Joint Puller
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
09649-17010
Steering Knuckle Tool
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151F)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
OIL
TRANSAXLE
OIL
OIL
SEAL(U241E)
Front Suspension Arm Bushing
Remover & Replacer
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U140F)
OIL
Replacer
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U140F)
OIL
09930-00010
Drive Shaft Nut Chisel
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
09950-70010
Handle Set
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U140F)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
09726-27012
(09726-02041)
TRANSAXLE
SEAL(U151E)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151F)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U241E)
OIL
OIL
OIL
OIL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
95
02-48
PREPARATION
(09951-07150)
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
Handle 150
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151E)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
OIL
OIL
SEAL(U241E)
(09951-07200)
Handle 200
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U140F)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
OIL
OIL
SEAL(U151F)
Recomended Tools
09011-12301
Socket Wrench 30 mm
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
09040-0001 1
Hexagon Wrench Set
TRANSMISSION
WIRE(U151E/U151F)
AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
TRANSMISSION
VALVE
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
(09043-20100)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 10
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U140F)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
BODY
TRANSAXLE
OIL
OIL
SEAL(U151E)
TRANSMISSION
WIRE(U151E/U151F)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151F)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U241E)
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 10
OIL
TRANSAXLE
TRANSMISSION
WIRE(U241E/U140F)
TRANSMISSION
VALVE
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
(09043-20100)
OIL
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U140F)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
BODY
OIL
OIL
SEAL(U151E)
TRANSMISSION
WIRE(U151E/U151F)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151F)
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U241E)
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
OIL
OIL
TRANSAXLE
TRANSMISSION
WIRE(U241E/U140F)
TRANSMISSION
VALVE
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
BODY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
96
02-49
PREPARATION
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
SHIFT LEVER ASSY(ATM)
TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
ASSY(ATM)
09090-04020
Engine Sling Device
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U140F)
TRANSMISSION
VALVE
ASSY(U151E/U151F)
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U151E/U151F)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
AUTOMATIC
ASSY(U241E/U140F)
BODY
TRANSAXLE
FRONT
DIFFERENTIAL
SEAL(U151F)
(09043-20060)
OIL
OIL
TRANSAXLE
SSM
08833-00070
”Adhesive 1324,”
THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
08833-00080
Adhesive 1344
THREE BOND 1344
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Equipment
Straight edge
Torque converter
Vernier calipers
Torque converter
Dial indicator or dial indicator with magnetic base
Drive plate
Punch
Torque wrench
Lubricant
Item
Capacity
Classification
U140F:
Automatic transaxle fluid
Dry fill
w/ air cooled oil cooler
w/o air cooled oil cooler
Drain and refill
8.75 liters (9.2 US qts, 7.7 lmp.qts)
8.35 liters (8.8 US qts, 7.3 lmp.qts)
3.90 liters (4.1 US qts, 3.4 lmp.qts)
U241E:
Automatic transaxle fluid
Dry fill
w/ air cooled oil cooler
w/o air cooled oil cooler
Drain and refill
9.00 liters (9.5 US qts, 7.9 lmp.qts)
8.60 liters (9.1 US qts, 7.6 lmp.qts)
3.30 liters (3.5 US qts, 2.9 lmp.qts)
U151E
Automatic transaxle fluid
Dry fill
Drain and refill
8.8 liter (9.3 USqts, 7.7 lmp.qts)
3.5 liter (3.7 USqts, 3.1 lmp.qts)
U151F
Automatic transaxle fluid
Dry fill
Drain and refill
9.0 liter (9.5 USqts, 7.9 lmp.qts)
3.6 liter (3.8 USqts, 3.2 lmp.qts)
ATF Type T-IV
ATF Type T-IV
ATF type T-IV
ATF type T-IV
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
97
02-28
PREPARATION
-
DIFFERENTIAL
DIFFERENTIAL
023GL-01
PREPARATION
SST
09223-00010
Cover & Seal Replacer
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
09308-00010
Oil Seal Puller
REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR
SHAFT SEAL OIL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
09308-10010
Oil Seal Puller
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
09316-12010
Transfer Bearing Replacer
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
09325-20010
Transmission Oil Plug
REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR
SHAFT SEAL OIL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
09330-00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
09370-50010
Drive Line Angle Gauge
REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR
SHAFT SEAL OIL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
09504-2201 1
Differential Side Bearing
Replacer
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
09506-30012
Differential Drive Pinion Rear
Bearing Cone Replacer
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
09550-00032
Replacer
REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR
SHAFT SEAL OIL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
09554-22010
Differential Oil Seal Replacer
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
09556-22010
Drive Pinion Front Bearing
Remover
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
76
02-29
PREPARATION
-
DIFFERENTIAL
09570-24010
Differential Mounting Cushion
Remover & Replacer
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
09636-20010
Upper Ball Joint Dust Cover
Replacer
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
09930-00010
Drive Shaft Nut Chisel
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR
SHAFT SEAL OIL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
REAR(4WD)
09950-00020
Bearing Remover
ASSY
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
09950-30012
Puller A Set
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
(09951-03010)
Upper Plate
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
(09953-03010)
Center Bolt
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
(09954-03010)
Arm
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
(09955-03030)
Lower Plate 130
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
(09956-03020)
Adapter 18
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
09950-4001 1
Puller B Set
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
(09951-04020)
Hanger 200
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
77
02-30
PREPARATION
-
DIFFERENTIAL
(09953-04030)
Center Bolt 200
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
(09954-04010)
Arm 25
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
(09955-04061)
Claw No.6
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
(09957-04010)
Attachment
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
(09958-0401 1)
Holder
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
Replacer Set
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
09950-60010
REAR(4WD)
(09951-00360)
Replacer 36
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
Replacer 62
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
Replacer Set No.2
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
(09951-00710)
Replacer 71
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
ASSY
09950-70010
Handle Set
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR
(09951-00620)
09950-60020
SHAFT SEAL OIL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
REAR(4WD)
(09951-07150)
Handle 150
ASSY
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
(09951-07200)
Handle 200
REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR
SHAFT SEAL OIL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
78
02-31
PREPARATION
-
DIFFERENTIAL
Recomended Tools
09011-12301
Socket Wrench 30 mm
REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR
SHAFT SEAL OIL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY
REAR(4WD)
09025-00010
Torque Wrench (30 kgf-cm)
DIFFERENTIAL
REAR(4WD)
CARRIER
09040-0001 1
Hexagon Wrench Set
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL
SEAL(4WD)
REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR
SHAFT SEAL OIL(4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
REAR(4WD)
ASSY
ASSY
Equipment
Dial indicator
Torque wrench
Alignment tester
Toe-in gauge
Deep socket wrench 24 mm
Lubricant
Item
Differential oil
Capacity
Classification
0.90 0.05 liters
(0.95 0.05 US qts, 0.75 0.04 lmp.qts)
Hypoid gear oil API GL-5
Above -18C (0F)
SAE 90
Below -18C (0F)
SAE 80W or 80W-90
SSM
08826-00090
”Seal Packing 1281,”
THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
(FIPG)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
79
02-32
PREPARATION
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
023GF-01
PREPARATION
SST
09240-00020
Wire Gauge Set
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
REAR DRIVE SHAFT(4WD)
09316-6001 1
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
(09316-0001 1)
Replacer Pipe
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
(09316-00031)
Replacer ”B”
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
09325-20010
Transmission Oil Plug
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
09330-00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
09370-50010
Drive Line Angle Gauge
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
09520-00031
Rear Axle Shaft Puller
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
09520-01010
Drive Shaft Remover Attachment
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
09520-24010
Differential Side Gear Shaft
Puller
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
Shocker Set
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
Rear Axle Shaft Puller
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
REAR DRIVE SHAFT(4WD)
(09520-32040)
09521-24010
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
80
02-33
PREPARATION
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
09527-1001 1
Rear Axle Shaft Bearing Remover
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
09527-1701 1
Rear Axle Shaft Bearing Remover
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
09527-2101 1
Rear Axle Shaft Bearing Remover
REAR DRIVE SHAFT(4WD)
09608-16042
Front Hub Bearing Adjusting Tool
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
(09608-02021)
Bolt & Nut
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
(09608-02041)
Retainer
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
09608-32010
Steering Knuckle Oil Seal
Replacer
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
09628-1001 1
Ball Joint Puller
FRONT AXLE LH HUB BOLT
REAR AXLE LH HUB BOLT
09628-6201 1
Boll Joint Puller
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
09710-04081
Base
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
09710-30021
Suspension Bushing Tool Set
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
Bushing Remover Base
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
Lower Control Shaft Bearing
Replacer
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
(09710-03141)
09726-40010
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
81
02-34
PREPARATION
09930-00010
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
Drive Shaft Nut Chisel
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
REAR DRIVE SHAFT(4WD)
REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY
LH(4WD)
REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY
LH(4WD)
09950-00020
Bearing Remover
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
REAR DRIVE SHAFT(4WD)
09950-4001 1
Puller B Set
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
(09951-04020)
Hanger 200
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
(09953-04030)
Center Bolt 200
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
(09954-04010)
Arm 25
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
(09955-04061)
Claw No.6
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
(09957-04010)
Attachment
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
(09958-0401 1)
Holder
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
09950-60010
Replacer Set
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
(09951-00430)
Replacer 43
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
Replacer Set No.2
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
09950-60020
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
82
02-35
PREPARATION
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
(09951-00710)
Replacer 71
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
(09951-00750)
Replacer 75
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
(09951-00810)
Replacer 81
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
09950-70010
Handle Set
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
Socket Wrench 30 mm
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
REAR DRIVE SHAFT(4WD)
Recomended Tools
09011-12301
REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY
LH(4WD)
REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY
LH(4WD)
09040-0001 1
Hexagon Wrench Set
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY(4WD)
Expander Set
REAR DRIVE SHAFT(4WD)
No. 4 Claw
REAR DRIVE SHAFT(4WD)
Snap Ring No.1 Expander
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
(09043-20060)
09904-00010
(09904-00050)
09905-00012
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
83
02-36
PREPARATION
09905-00013
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
Snap Ring Pliers
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
Equipment
Torque wrench
Dial gauge with magnetic base
Dial indicator
Alighment tester
Toe-in gauge
Lubricant
Item
Front drive shaft
3MZ-FE (FF)
Except 3MZ-FE (FF)
Capacity
Outboard joint grease
Inboard joint grease
Outboard joint grease
Inboard joint grease
205 to 225 g (7.2 to 8.0 oz.)
155 to 175 g (5.5 to 6.2 oz.)
190 to 200 g (6.7 to 7.0 oz.)
175 to 155 g (6.2 to 6.5 oz.)
Outboard joint grease
Inboard joint grease
95 to 105 g (3.4 to 3.7 oz.)
125.5 to 135.5 g (4.4 to 4.7 oz.)
Rear drive shaft
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
84
02-69
PREPARATION
-
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
020XS-03
PREPARATION
Equipment
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
117
02-62
PREPARATION
-
WIPER & WASHER
WIPER & WASHER
023HE-01
PREPARATION
SST
09843-18040
Diagnosis Check Wire No.2
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSY
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
Test Lead Set
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
Recomended Tools
(09083-00150)
Equipment
Voltmeter
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
110
02-43
PREPARATION
-
BRAKE
BRAKE
023GV-03
PREPARATION
SST
09023-00101
Union Nut Wrench 10 mm
BRAKE FLUID
BRAKE
MASTER
CYLINDER SUB-ASSY
W/PLATE
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSY
FRONT BRAKE
REAR BRAKE
BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY
09214-7601 1
Crankshaft Pulley Replacer
SKID CONTROL SENSOR(FF)
09520-00031
Rear Axle Shaft Puller
SKID CONTROL SENSOR(FF)
Shocker
SKID CONTROL SENSOR(FF)
09521-00020
Drive Shaft Boot Clamping Tool
SKID CONTROL SENSOR(FF)
09737-00020
Brake Booster Push Rod Wrench
BRAKE
MASTER
CYLINDER SUB-ASSY
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSY
09950-00020
Bearing Remover
SKID CONTROL SENSOR(FF)
09950-50013
Puller C Set
STEERING SENSOR
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
STEERING SENSOR
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
STEERING SENSOR
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
STEERING SENSOR
(09954-05021)
Claw No.2
STEERING SENSOR
(09520-00040)
W/PLATE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
91
02-44
PREPARATION
-
BRAKE
Recomended Tools
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
STEERING SENSOR
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSY
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Equipment
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Micrometer
Torque wrench
Slide calipers
Lubricant
Item
Capacity
Classification
Brake fluid
-
SAE J1703 or FMVSS No. 116 DOT3
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
92
02-64
PREPARATION
-
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
020XP-03
PREPARATION
Recomended Tools
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
HORN SYSTEM
Test Lead Set
HORN SYSTEM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
112
02-61
PREPARATION
-
LIGHTING
LIGHTING
023HD-01
PREPARATION
Recomended Tools
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
LIGHTING SYSTEM
(09083-00150)
Test Lead Set
LIGHTING SYSTEM
(09083-00150)
Test Lead Set
LIGHTING SYSTEM
09082-00040
Equipment
Voltmeter
Ohmmeter
Torque wrench
LICENCE PLATE LAMP ASSY
Sandpaper (#400)
HEADLAMP UNIT LH
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
109
02-58
PREPARATION
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
023H4-02
PREPARATION
SST
09082-00700
SRS Airbag Deployment Tool
HORN BUTTON ASSY
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY LH
09082-00750
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub-harness No.3
FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY LH
09082-00780
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub-harness No.6
HORN BUTTON ASSY
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
09082-00802
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub-Harness No. 8
HORN BUTTON ASSY
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(09082-10801)
Wire A
HORN BUTTON ASSY
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(09082-20801)
Wire B
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(09082-30801)
Wire C
HORN BUTTON ASSY
09950-50013
Puller C Set
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(09954-05021)
Claw No.2
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
106
02-59
PREPARATION
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Recomended Tools
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
HORN BUTTON ASSY
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Equipment
Torque wrench
Feeler gauge
Bolt Length: 35.0 mm (1.378 in.) Pitch: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Diameter: 6.0 mm (0.236 in.)
Airbag disposal
Tire Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.) Inner diameter: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
Airbag disposal
Tire with disc wheel Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
Airbag disposal
Plastic bag
Airbag disposal
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
107
02-27
PREPARATION
-
TIRE & WHEEL
TIRE & WHEEL
020XE-01
PREPARATION
Equipment
Tire pressure gauge
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Wheel balancer
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
75
02-24
PREPARATION
-
FRONT SUSPENSION
FRONT SUSPENSION
023DS-03
PREPARATION
SST
09023-12701
Union Nut Wrench 17 mm
STABILIZER BAR FRONT(4WD)
STABILIZER BAR FRONT(FF)
09628-6201 1
Boll Joint Puller
LOWER BALL JOINT ASSY FRONT
LH
STABILIZER BAR FRONT(4WD)
STABILIZER BAR FRONT(FF)
Coil Spring Compressor
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT
LH
(09727-00010)
Bolt Set
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT
LH
(09727-00021)
Arm Set
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT
LH
09930-00010
Drive Shaft Nut Chisel
LOWER BALL JOINT ASSY FRONT
LH
09011-12301
Socket Wrench 30 mm
LOWER BALL JOINT ASSY FRONT
LH
09040-0001 1
Hexagon Wrench Set
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT
LH
STABILIZER BAR FRONT(4WD)
09727-30021
Recomended Tools
STABILIZER BAR FRONT(FF)
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT
LH
STABILIZER BAR FRONT(4WD)
STABILIZER BAR FRONT(FF)
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT
LH
STABILIZER BAR FRONT(4WD)
STABILIZER BAR FRONT(FF)
09044-00020
Torx Socket E10
PNEUMATIC FRONT LH W/SHOCK
ABSORBER CYLINDER ASSY
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
72
02-25
PREPARATION
-
FRONT SUSPENSION
Equipment
Torque wrench
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Drill (Safety equipment: protective goggles, etc.)
Shock absorber disposal
Tire pressure gauge
Alignment tester
Toe-in gauge
Angle gauge
Slide Calipers
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
73
02-26
PREPARATION
-
REAR SUSPENSION
REAR SUSPENSION
023HG-01
PREPARATION
SST
09325-20010
Transmission Oil Plug
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY
NO.1 LH(4WD)
09727-30021
Coil Spring Compressor
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH
COIL SPRING
(09727-00010)
Bolt Set
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH
COIL SPRING
(09727-00021)
Arm Set
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH
COIL SPRING
(09727-00031)
Compressor
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH
COIL SPRING
Hexagon Wrench Set
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH
COIL SPRING
STABILIZER BAR REAR(4WD)
Recomended Tools
09040-0001 1
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY
NO.1 LH(FF)
STABILIZER BAR REAR(FF)
(09043-20050)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 5
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH
COIL SPRING
STABILIZER BAR REAR(4WD)
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY
NO.1 LH(FF)
STABILIZER BAR REAR(FF)
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH
COIL SPRING
Equipment
Torque wrench
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Slide calipers
Wheel balancer
Tire pressure gauge
Alignment tester
Toe-in gauge
Camber-caster-kingpin gauge
Drill (Safety equipment: protective goggles, etc.)
Shock absorber disposal
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
74
02-45
PREPARATION
-
PARKING BRAKE
PARKING BRAKE
023CK-01
PREPARATION
SST
09930-00010
Drive Shaft Nut Chisel
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
09011-12301
Socket Wrench 30 mm
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL
ASSY
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
Recomended Tools
Equipment
Torque wrench
Slide calipers
Dial indicator
Brake drum gauge
Feeler gauge
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
93
02-72
PREPARATION
-
VEHICLE CONTROL SYSTEM
VEHICLE CONTROL SYSTEM
021SF-02
PREPARATION
Recomended Tools
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
IGNITION SWITH
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
120
02-68
PREPARATION
-
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
020XH-04
PREPARATION
Recommended tools
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
Power Door Lock System
Transmitter Battery
Door Control Transmitter
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
116
02-50
PREPARATION
-
STEERING COLUMN
STEERING COLUMN
020WQ-02
PREPARATION
SST
09608-06041
Front Hub Inner Bearing Cone
Replacer
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
09950-50013
Puller C Set
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
(09954-05021)
Claw No.2
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
09904-00010
Expander Set
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
No. 1 Claw
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
Recomended Tools
(09904-00020)
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
98
02-51
PREPARATION
-
POWER STEERING
POWER STEERING
023GW-02
PREPARATION
SST
09023-12701
Union Nut Wrench 17 mm
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09023-38201
Union Nut Wrench 12mm
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09249-63010
Torque Wrench Adaptor
VANE PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
09521-24010
Rear Axle Shaft Puller
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09527-2101 1
Rear Axle Shaft Bearing Remover
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09612-00012
Rack & Pinion Steering Rack
Housing Stand
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09612-2201 1
Tilt Handle Bearing Replacer
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09612-24014
Steering Gear Housing Overhaul
Tool Set
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
Steering Rack Shaft Bushing
Puller
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09616-0001 1
Steering Worm Bearing Adjusting
Socket
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09628-6201 1
Boll Joint Puller
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09630-00014
Power Steering Gear Housing
Overhaul Tool Set
VANE PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
(09613-2201 1)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
99
02-52
PREPARATION
-
POWER STEERING
Vane Pump Bracket
VANE PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
09631-10021
Rack Stopper Wrench
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09631-12071
Steering Rack Oil Seal Test Tool
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
Packing
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09631-20081
Seal Ring Tool
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09631-33010
Steering Rack Cover ”I”
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09922-10010
Variable Open Wrench
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09950-60010
Replacer Set
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
VANE PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
VANE PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09951-00180)
Replacer 18
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(09951-00250)
Replacer 25
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(09951-00280)
Replacer 28
VANE PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
(09951-00290)
Replacer 29
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(09951-00320)
Replacer 32
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(09631-00132)
(09633-00010)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
100
02-53
PREPARATION
-
POWER STEERING
(09951-00330)
Replacer 33
VANE PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09951-00340)
Replacer 34
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(09951-00400)
Replacer 40
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(09951-00450)
Replacer 45
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(09952-06010)
Adapter
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09950-70010
Handle Set
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
VANE PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
VANE PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
VANE PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
VANE PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09951-07150)
Handle 150
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(09951-07360)
Handle 360
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
Variable Pin Wrench Set
VANE PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09962-01000)
Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assy
VANE PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
(09963-01000)
Pin 10
VANE PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
09960-10010
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
101
02-54
PREPARATION
-
POWER STEERING
Recomended Tools
09025-00010
Torque Wrench (30 kgf-cm)
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
VANE PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
09040-0001 1
Hexagon Wrench Set
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
09905-00012
Snap Ring No.1 Expander
VANE PUMP ASSY(2AZ-FE)
VANE PUMP ASSY(3MZ-FE)
Equipment
Caliper gauge
Belt tension gauge
Vernier calipers
Dial indicator
Feeler gauge
Micrometer
Torque wrench
Lubricant
Item
Power steering fluid (Total)
Capacity
Classification
1.0 liters (1.1 US qts, 0.9 lmp.qts)
ATF DEXRON® II or III
SSM
08833-00080
Adhesive 1344
THREE BOND 1344
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
RACK & PINION POWER STEERING
GEAR ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
102
02-73
PREPARATION
-
CRUISE CONTROL
CRUISE CONTROL
023FD-02
PREPARATION
Recomended Tools
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
Torx is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
Equipment
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
121
02-6
PREPARATION
-
INTAKE
INTAKE
023H7-01
PREPARATION
Equipment
Hand-held vacuum pump
Ohmmeter
Torque wrench
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
54
03-1
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
STANDARD BOLT
STANDARD BOLT
0305S-04
HOW TO DETERMINE BOLT STRENGTH
Bolt Type
Hexagon Head Bolt
Normal Recess Bolt
Deep Recess Bolt
Stud Bolt
Weld Bolt
4
Class
4T
No Mark
No Mark
No Mark
5
5T
6
6T
w/ Washer
w/ Washer
7
7T
8
8T
9
9T
10
10T
11
11T
B06431
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
122
03-3
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
STANDARD BOLT
0305U-04
HOW TO DETERMINE NUT STRENGTH
Nut Type
Present Standard
Hexagon Nut
Old Standard Hexagon Nut
Cold Forging Nut
Class
Cutting Processed Nut
4N
No Mark
5N (4T)
No Mark (w/ Washer)
No Mark (w/ Washer)
No Mark
6N
6N
7N (5T)
*
8N
8N
10N (7T)
10N
No Mark
11N
11N
12N
12N
*: Nut with 1 or more marks on one side surface of the nut.
B06432
HINT:
Use the nut with the same number of the nut strength classification or the greater than the bolt strength classification number when tightening parts with a bolt and nut.
Example: Bolt = 4T
Nut = 4N or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
124
03-2
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
STANDARD BOLT
0305T-04
SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR STANDARD BOLTS
Specified torque
Class
Diameter
mm
Pitch
mm
Hexagon head bolt
Hexagon flange bolt
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
4T
6
8
10
12
14
16
1
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.5
1.5
5
12.5
26
47
74
115
55
130
260
480
760
1,150
48 in.·lbf
9
19
35
55
83
6
14
29
53
84
-
60
145
290
540
850
-
52 in.·lbf
10
21
39
61
-
5T
6
8
10
12
14
16
1
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.5
1.5
6.5
15.5
32
59
91
140
65
160
330
600
930
1,400
56 in.·lbf
12
24
43
67
101
7.5
17.5
36
65
100
-
75
175
360
670
1,050
-
65 in.·lbf
13
26
48
76
-
6T
6
8
10
12
14
16
1
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.5
1.5
8
19
39
71
110
170
80
195
400
730
1,100
1,750
69 in.·lbf
14
29
53
80
127
9
21
44
80
125
-
90
210
440
810
1,250
-
78 in.·lbf
15
32
59
90
-
7T
6
8
10
12
14
16
1
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.5
1.5
10.5
25
52
95
145
230
110
260
530
970
1,500
2,300
8
19
38
70
108
166
12
28
58
105
165
-
120
290
590
1,050
1,700
-
9
21
43
76
123
-
8T
8
10
12
1.25
1.25
1.25
29
61
110
300
620
1,100
22
45
80
33
68
120
330
690
1,250
24
50
90
9T
8
10
12
1.25
1.25
1.25
34
70
125
340
710
1,300
25
51
94
37
78
140
380
790
1,450
27
57
105
10T
8
10
12
1.25
1.25
1.25
38
78
140
390
800
1,450
28
58
105
42
88
155
430
890
1,600
31
64
116
11T
8
10
12
1.25
1.25
1.25
42
87
155
430
890
1,600
31
64
116
47
97
175
480
990
1,800
35
72
130
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
123
03-34
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
FRONT SUSPENSION
FRONT SUSPENSION
03052-03
SERVICE DATA
Vehicle height
FF
Front: A Rear: D Front: A Rear: D -
4WD
Toe-in (total)
Wheel angle
FF
4WD
Front wheel al
alignmwnt
B:
C:
B:
C:
120.1 mm (4.73 in.)
40.5 mm (1.59 in.)
110.1 mm (4.33 in.)
30.5 mm (1.20 in.)
0 10’ (0 0.16, 0 2 mm, 0 0.08 in.)
Rack end length difference 1.5 mm (0.059 in.) or less
Inside wheel:
Outside wheel: Reference:
Inside wheel:
Outside wheel: Reference:
35°28’ ± 2° (35.47° ± 2°)
31°13’ (31.22°)
35°41’ ± 2° (35.68° ± 2°)
31°22’ (31.37°)
Camber
FF:
4WD:
Right-left error
-0 °40’ ± 45’ (-0.67° ± 0.75°)
-0 °35’ ± 45’ (-0.58° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
2°45’ ± 45’ (2.75° ± 0.75°)
Caster
Right-left error
45’ (0.75°) or less
Steering axis inclination
FF:
4WD:
Right-left error
Front suspension
10°45’ ± 45’ (10.75° ± 0.75°)
10°35’ ± 45’ (10.58° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
Lower ball joint turning torque
0.98 to 3.43 N·m (10 to 35 kgf·cm, 8.7 to 30 in.·lbf)
Stabilizer bar link ball joint turning torque
0.05 to 1.96 N·m (0.5 to 20 kgf·cm, 0.4 to 17.4 in.·lbf)
A: Ground clearance of front wheel center
B: Ground clearance of lower suspension arm No. 2 set bolt center
C: Ground clearance of strut rod set bolt center
D: Ground clearance of rear wheel center
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
155
03-35
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
FRONT SUSPENSION
03053-03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Hub nut
103
1,050
76
Tie rod end lock nut
74
755
55
Steering knuckle x Shock absorber
230
2,350
170
Lower ball joint x Lower suspension arm
127
1,300
94
Suspension support x Body
80
816
59
Suspension support x Piston rod
49
500
36
Flexible hose and ABS speed sensor wire harness bracket x Shock absorber
19
194
14
Lower suspension arm set bolt
200
206
2,040
2,100
148
152
Transverse engine engine mounting insulator set nut
87
887
64
Stabilizer bar bracket x Suspension member
16
163
12
Stabilizer bar link set nut
74
755
55
Front axle assy x Front brake caliper assy
104
1060
77
Lower ball joint assy front set nut
123
1250
91
Front side:
Rear side:
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
156
03-38
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
TIRE & WHEEL
TIRE & WHEEL
03050-02
SERVICE DATA
Tire size: P225/70R16 101S
Front, Rear
210 kPa (2.1 kgf/cm2, 30 psi)
Tire runout
1.4 mm (0.055 in.) or less
Imbalance after adjustment
8.0 g (0.018 lb) or less
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
159
03-49
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
PARKING BRAKE
PARKING BRAKE
0305C-02
SERVICE DATA
Parking brake pedal travel at 300 N (31 kgf, 67.46 lbf):
5 to 7 clicks
Rear brake disc inside diameter
Standard 190 mm (7.480 in.)
Maximum 191 mm (7.520 in.)
Parking brake shoe lining thickness
Standard 2.5 mm (0.098 in.)
Maximum 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Parking brake shoe clearance between rear shoe and lever
Less than 0.35 mm (0.014 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
170
03-50
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
PARKING BRAKE
0305D-02
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part Tightened
Wheel nut
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
103
1,050
76
Parking brake cable lock nut
6
61
53 in.⋅lbf
Parking brake control pedal set bolt
39
400
29
Parking brake cable assy No.1 x Body
Bolt
nut
8.5
6
87
61
75 in.⋅lbf
53 in.⋅lbf
Parking brake cable assy No.3 x Body
Bolt A
Bolt B
nut
8.5
39
6
87
400
61
75 in.⋅lbf
29
53 in.⋅lbf
8
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Parking brake cable No.3 x Backing plate
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
171
03-55
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
STEERING COLUMN
STEERING COLUMN
0304Y-03
SERVICE DATA
Steering wheel freeplay
Steering main shaft length
Maximum 30 mm (1.18 in.)
Standard length
504.5 1 mm (19.862 0.039 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
176
03-56
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
STEERING COLUMN
0304Z-04
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Universal joint assy x Main shaft assy
35
360
26
Steering column assembly set bolt and nut
21
210
15
Intermediate shaft sub-assy x Universal joint assembly
35
360
26
Intermediate shaft sub-assy x Control valve shaft
35
360
26
Steering wheel set nut
50
510
37
Steering wheel pad set screw (Torx screw)
8.8
90
78 in.·lbf
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
177
03-57
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
POWER STEERING
POWER STEERING
0304W-05
SERVICE DATA
POWER STEERING FLUID
Fluid level rise
Fluid pressure at idle speed with valve closed
Maximum 5 mm (0.20 in.)
7,800 to 8,300 kPa (80 to 85 kgf/cm2, 1,131 to 1,204 psi)
STEERING WHEEL
Steering effort at idle speed
(Reference) 6.0 N·m (60 kgf·cm, 53 in.·lbf)
VANE PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Vane pump rotating torque
Vane pump shaft and vane pump housing bush clearance
Vane plate thickness
Vane plate and vane rotor groove clearance
Spring free length
0.27 N⋅m (2.8 kgf⋅cm, 2.4 in.⋅lbf) or less
Maximum 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Minimum 1.405 to 1.411 mm (0.05531 to 0.05555 in.)
Maximum 0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
Minimum 30.3 mm (1.193 in.)
VANE PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Vane pump rotating torque
Vane pump shaft and vane pump housing oil clearance
Vane plate thickness
Clearance between the rotor groove and plate
Spring free length
0.27 N·m (2.8 kgf·cm, 2.4 in.·lbf) or less
STD 0.027 to 0.054 mm (0.00106 to 0.00213 in.)
Maximum 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Minimum 1.397 to 1.403 mm (0.0550 to 0.0552 in.)
Maximum 0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
Minimum 32.24 mm (1.2693 in.)
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
Steering rack runout
Maximum 0.3 mm (0.0118 in.)
Tie rod assy stad bolt torque
(Turning) 0.49 to 3.43 N·m (5.0 to 35.0 kgf·cm, 4.3 to 30.4 in.·lbf)
Total preload (Control valve rotating torque)
(Turning) 1.2 to 1.5 N·m (12.2 to 15.3 kgf·cm, 10.6 to 13.3 in.·lbf)
Rack boot clamp clearance
3.0 mm (0.118 in.) or less
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
178
03-58
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
POWER STEERING
0304X-05
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Housing rear x Housing front
22
224
16
Oil pressure switch
21
214
15
Pressure port union
69
704
51
Suction port union set bolt
12
122
9
37 (26)
264 (377)
19 (27)
52
525
38
Pump bracket front x Housing front
43
438
32
Housing rear x Housing front
24
245
18
VANE PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Pump assy set bolt
Pressure feed tube assy set union bolt
VANE PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Pump bracket rear x Housing rear
43
438
32
Pressure port union
83
846
61
Suction port union set bolt
13
133
10
Vane pump pulley set nut
44
449
32
Pump assy set bolt
43
440
32
Pressure feed tube assy set union bolt
52
525
38
Oil pressure switch
21
214
15
Control valve housing set bolt
21
214
15
Control valve shaft lock nut
25
250
18
Rack housing cap
59
597
43
Rack guide spring cap lock nut
51 (69)
515 (699)
38 (51)
Rack x Rack end sub-assy
60 (84)
616 (851)
45 (62)
74
750
54
11 (13)
116 (127)
8 (9)
70
714
52
Pressure feed tube assy union nut
22 (25)
230 (250)
16 (18)
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
Tie rod assy lock nut
Turn pressure tube union nut
Steering link assy set bolt
Pressure feed tube clamp set bolt
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
Return tube clamp set nut
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
Stabilizer bracket No.1 x Suspension crossmember
16
163
12
Intermediate shaft assy x Steering link assy
35
360
26
( ): For use without SST
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
179
03-61
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0305F-03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Horn button assy x Steering wheel assy
Part Tightened
8.8
90
78 in.⋅lbf
Steering wheel assy x Steering column assy
50
510
37
Front passenger airbag assy x Instrument panel reinforcement
20
204
15
Front passenger airbag assy x Instrument panel sub-assy
5.6
57
49 in. lbf
Curtain shield airbag assy x Body
14
143
10
Airbag sensor assy center x Body
17.5
179
13
Airbag front sensor x Body
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Side airbag sensor assy x Body
17.5
179
13
Front seat outer belt assy x Body
7.5
75
67 in. lbf
Airbag sensor rear x Body
17.5
179
13
Seat position airbag sensor x Front LH seat assy
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Front LH seat assy x Body
36.7
374
27
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
182
03-4
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
03048-02
SERVICE DATA
2AZ-FE:
Throttle body
Standard throttle valve opening percentage
60% or more
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Intake air flow meter assy
Resistance
Camshaft timing oil control valve assy
Resistance
Throttle body assy
Resistance
E.F.I. engine coolant temperature sensor
Resistance
Knock sensor
Resistance
Standard voltage
0.6 to 1.0 V
4 (THA) - 5 (E2)
at -20C (-4F)
at 20C (68F)
at 60C (140F)
13.6 to 18.4 kΩ
2.21 to 2.69 kΩ
0.493 to 0.667 kΩ
at 20C (68F)
6.9 to 7.9 Ω
at 20C (68F)
2 (M+) - 1 (M-)
0.3 to 100 kΩ
Approx. 20C (68F)
Approx. 80C (176F)
at 20C (68F)
EFI relay
Specified condition
C/OPN relay
Specified condition
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ
120 to 280 kΩ
3-5
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3-5
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3MZ-FE:
Throttle body
Standard throttle valve opening percentage
60% or more
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Intake air flow meter assy
Resistance
Camshaft timing oil control valve assy
Resistance
Throttle body assy
Resistance
E.F.I. engine coolant temperature sensor
Resistance
Knock sensor
Resistance
EFI relay
Specified condition
C/OPN relay
Specified condition
Standard voltage
0.6 to 1.0 V
4 (THA) - 5 (E2)
at -20C (-4F)
at 20C (68F)
at 60C (140F)
13.6 to 18.4 kΩ
2.21 to 2.69 kΩ
0.493 to 0.667 kΩ
at 20C (68F)
6.9 to 7.9 Ω
at 20C (68F)
2 (M+) - 1 (M-)
0.3 to 100 kΩ
Approx. 20C (68F)
Approx. 80C (176F)
at 20C (68F)
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ
120 to 280 kΩ
3-5
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3-5
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
125
03-5
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
03049-02
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
2AZ-FE:
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Throttle body assy x Intake manifold
Part Tightened
30
305
22
Knock sensor x Cylinder block sub-assy
20
199
14
Intake manifold x Cylinder head sub-assy
30
305
22
ECM x Instrument panel reinforcement
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
ECM x Blower assy
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
Accelerator pedal rod assy x Body
4.9
50
43 in.⋅lbf
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
3MZ-FE:
Part Tightened
Front suspension upper brace center x Body
80
815
59
V-bank cover sub-assy x Cylinder head cover sub-assy LH
(w/ Performance Rod)
7.9
81
70 in.⋅lbf
Throttle body assy x Intake air connector
11
112
8
Knock sensor x Cylinder block sub-assy
20
199
14
Water outlet x Cylinder head sub-assy
15
153
11
Water outlet x Cylinder head LH
15
153
11
Intake manifold x Cylinder head sub-assy
15
153
11
Intake manifold x Cylinder head LH
15
153
11
Ground cable x Intake manifold
8.4
86
74 in.⋅lbf
ECM x Instrument panel reinforcement
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
ECM x Blower assy
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
Accelerator pedal rod assy x Body
4.9
50
43 in.⋅lbf
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
126
03-6
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
FUEL
FUEL
0304A-02
SERVICE DATA
2AZ-FE:
304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 50 psi)
Fuel pressure
Fuel injector
Resistance
Injection volume
Difference between each cylinder
Fuel leakage
Fuel pump
Resistance
at 20C (68F)
11.6 to 12.4 Ω
76 to 92 cm2 (4.6 to 5.6 cu in.) per 15 seconds
16 cm3 (1.0 cu in.) or less
1 drop or less per 12 minutes
at 20C (68F)
0.2 to 3.0 Ω
3MZ-FE:
304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 50 psi)
Fuel pressure
Fuel injector
Resistance
Injection volume
Difference between each cylinder
Fuel leakage
Fuel pump
Resistance
at 20C (68F)
13.4 to 14.2Ω
60 to 73 cm2 (3.7 to 4.5 cu in.) per 15 seconds
13 cm3 (0.8 cu in.) or less
1 drop or less per 12 minutes
at 20C (68F)
0.2 to 3.0 Ω
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
127
03-7
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
FUEL
0304B-02
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
2AZ-FE:
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Fuel delivery pipe x Cylinder head
Part Tightened
20
204
15
Fuel tank band sub-assy No. 1 RH x Body
39
400
29
Fuel tank band sub-assy No. 1 LH x Body
39
400
29
Fuel tank protector x Fuel tank assy
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
Exhaust pipe assy center x Exhaust pipe assy front
48
490
35
Exhaust pipe assy center x Exhaust pipe assy tail
48
490
35
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Fuel delivery pipe sub-assy x Intake manifold
10
102
7
Fuel delivery pipe No. 2 x Intake manifold
10
102
7
Fuel pipe No. 2 union bolt x Fuel delivery pipe No. 2
33
331
24
Fuel pressure pulsation damper assy x Fuel delivery pipe sub-assy
33
331
24
Fuel pipe sub-assy No. 1 x Intake manifold
20
199
14
Surge tank stay No. 2 x Intake air surge tank
20
199
14
Surge tank stay No. 2 x Cylinder head
20
199
14
Surge tank stay No. 1 x Intake air surge tank
20
199
14
Surge tank stay No. 1 x Cylinder head
20
199
14
Engine hunger No. 1 x Intake air surge tank
20
199
14
Engine hunger No. 1 x Cylinder head
20
199
14
Pressure feed tube assy x Engine hunger No. 1
7.8
80
69 in.⋅lbf
Intake air surge tank x Intake manifold
28
286
21
Emission control valve set x Emission control valve bracket
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Fuel tank band sub-assy No. 1 RH x Body
39
400
29
Fuel tank band sub-assy No. 1 LH x Body
39
400
29
Fuel tank protector lower center x Fuel tank assy
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
Packing brake cable assy No. 2 x Body
5.4
55
48 in.⋅lbf
Exhaust pipe assy center x Exhaust pipe assy front
48
490
35
Exhaust pipe assy center x Exhaust pipe assy tail
48
490
35
3MZ-FE:
Part Tightened
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
128
03-8
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
EMISSION CONTROL
EMISSION CONTROL
0304C-02
SERVICE DATA
2AZ-FE
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
resistance
Oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
resistance
VSV for EVAP
resistance
at 20C (68F)
at 800C (1,472F)
0.8 to 1.4 Ω
1.8 to 3.2 Ω
at 20C (68F)
at 800C (1,472F)
11 to 16 Ω
23 to 32 Ω
at 20C (68F)
26 to 30 Ω
3MZ-FE
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
resistance
A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
resistance
Oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
resistance
Oxygen sensor (bank 2 sensor 2)
resistance
VSV for CCV
resistance
VSV for EVAP
resistance
at 20C (68F)
at 800C (1,472F)
0.8 to 1.4 Ω
1.8 to 3.2 Ω
at 20C (68F)
at 800C (1,472F)
0.8 to 1.4 Ω
1.8 to 3.2 Ω
at 20C (68F)
at 800C (1,472F)
11 to 16 Ω
23 to 32 Ω
at 20C (68F)
at 800C (1,472F)
11 to 16 Ω
23 to 32 Ω
at 20C (68F)
at 100C (212F)
25 to 30 Ω
32 to 40 Ω
at 20C (68F)
26 to 30 Ω
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
129
03-9
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
INTAKE
INTAKE
0304D-02
SERVICE DATA
3MZ-FE
Vacuum switching valve assy for IAC valve No.2
Resistance
at 20C (68F)
33 to 39 Ω
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
130
03-10
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
INTAKE
0304E-02
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
3MZ-FE
Part Tightened
Intake air control valve assy No. 2 x Intake air surge tank
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
10
102
7
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
131
03-1 1
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE MECHANICAL
0304P-02
SERVICE DATA
2AZ-FE
Ignition timing
w/ Terminals TC and CG of DLC3 connected
w/ Terminals TC and CG of DLC3 disconnected
Idle speed
Compression
A/T
Compression pressure
Minimum pressure
Difference between each cylinder
Valve clearance (cold)
8 to 12 BTDC @ idle
5 to 15 BTDC @ idle
610 to 710 rpm
1.360 kPa (13.9 kgf/cm2, 198 psi)
0.98 MPa (10 kgf/cm2, 142 psi)
100 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 14 psi)
Intake 0.19 to 0.29 mm (0.008 to 0.011 in.)
Exhaust 0.30 to 0.40 mm (0.012 to 0.016 in.)
Balanceshaft
Standard thrust clearance
Maximum thrust clearance
Standard oil clearance
Maximum oil clearance
Housing journal bore diameter
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Journal diameter
Bearing center wall thickness
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
0.050 to 0.090 mm (0.0020 to 0.0035 in.)
0.090 mm (0.0035 in.)
0.031 mm (0.0012 in.)
0.004 to 0.031 mm (0.0002 to 0.0012 in.)
26.000 to 26.006 mm (1.0236 to 1.0239 in.)
26.007 to 26.012 mm (1.0239 to 1.0241 in.)
26.013 to 26.018 mm (1.0241 to 1.0243 in.)
22.985 to 23.000 mm (0.9049 to 0.9055 in.)
1.486 to 1.489 mm (0.0585 to 0.0586 in.)
1.489 to 1.492 mm (0.0586 to 0.0587 in.)
1.492 to 1.495 mm (0.0587 to 0.0589 in.)
Oil pump drive sprocket
Minimum sprocket diameter (w/ chain)
48.2 mm (1.898 in.)
Crankshaft timing sprocket
Minimum sprocket diameter (w/ chain)
51.6 mm (2.031 in.)
Chain tensioner slipper
Maximum wear
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Chain vibration damper No. 1
Maximum wear
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Cylinder head set bolt
Specified bolt length
161.3 to 162.7 mm (6.3503 to 6.4055 in.)
Chain sub-assy
Maximum chain elongation
115.4 mm (4.543 in.)
Camshaft timing gear or sprocket
Minimum gear or sprocket diameter (w/ chain)
97.3 mm (3.831 in.)
Camshaft (Intake)
Maximum circle runout
Standard cam lobe height
MInimum cam lobe height
No. 1 journal diameter
Other journal diameter
Standard journal thrust clearance
Maximum journal thrust clearance
Standard journal oil clearance
Maximum journal oil clearance
Cylinder head journal bore diameter
Standard bearing center wall thickness
No. 1 journal bearing mark 1
No. 1 journal bearing mark 2
No. 1 journal bearing mark 3
Other journals
No. 1 journal
Other journals
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Camshaft journal diameter
0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
46.495 to 46.595 mm (1.8305 to 1.8344 in.)
46.385 mm (1.8262 in.)
35.971 to 35.985 mm (1.4162 to 1.4167 in.)
22.959 to 22.975 mm (0.9039 to 0.9045 in.)
0.040 to 0.095 mm (0.0016 to 0.0037 in.)
0.11 mm (0.0043 in.)
0.007 to 0.038 mm (0.0028 to 0.0015 in.)
0.008 to 0.038 mm (0.0031 to 0.0015 in.)
0.008 to 0.038 mm (0.0031 to 0.0015 in.)
0.025 to 0.062 mm (0.00098 to 0.00244 in.)
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
40.000 to 40.008 mm (1.57480 to 1.57511 in.)
40.009 to 40.017 mm (1.57515 to 1.57547 in.)
40.018 to 40.025 mm (1.57551 to 1.57578 in.)
2.000 to 2.004 mm (0.07874 to 0.07890 in.)
2.004 to 2.008 mm (0.07894 to 0.07905 in.)
2.009 to 2.012 mm (0.07909 to 0.07921 in.)
35.971 to 35.985 mm (1.41618 to 1.41673 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
132
03-12
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Camshaft No. 2 (Exhaust)
Maximum circle runout
Standard cam lobe height
Minimum cam lobe height
No. 1 journal diameter
Other journal diameter
Standard thrust clearance
Maximum thrust clearance
Standard journal oil clearance
Cylinder head journal bore diameter
Standard bearing center wall thickness
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
No. 1 journal
Other journals
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Camshaft journal diameter
0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
46.873 to 46.083 mm (1.8060 to 1.8143 in.)
45.873 mm (1.8060 in.)
35.971 to 35.985 mm (1.41618 to 1.41673 in.)
22.959 to 22.975 mm (0.9039 to 0.9045 in.)
0.080 to 0.135 mm (0.0032 to 0.0053 in.)
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
0.040 to 0.079 mm (0.00157 to 0.00311 in.)
0.025 to 0.062 mm (0.00098 to 0.00244 in.)
40.000 to 40.008 mm (1.57480 to 1.57511 in.)
40.009 to 40.017 mm (1.57515 to 1.57547 in.)
40.018 to 40.025 mm (1.57551 to 1.57578 in.)
2.000 to 2.004 mm (0.07874 to 0.07890 in.)
2.004 to 2.008 mm (0.07894 to 0.07905 in.)
2.009 to 2.012 mm (0.07909 to 0.07921 in.)
35.971 to 35.985 mm (1.4162 to 1.4167 in.)
Intake manifold
Maximum warpage
0.20 mm (0.079 in.)
Exhaust manifold
Maximum warpage
0.70 mm (0.0276 in.)
Cylinder head
Maximum warpage
Cylinder block side
Intake manifold side
Exhaust manifold side
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Inner compression spring
Free length
Maximum deviation
45.7 mm (1.799 in.)
1.6 mm (0.063 in.)
Intake valve
Standard overall length
Minimum overall length
Valve stem diameter
Standard margin thickness
Minimum margin thickness
101.71 mm (4.0043 in.)
101.21 mm (3.9846 in.)
5.470 to 5.485 mm (0.2154 to 0.2159 in.)
1.05 to 1.45 mm (0.0413 to 0.0571 in.)
0.50 to (0.0197 in.)
Exhaust valve
Standard overall length
Minimum overall length
Valve stem diameter
Standard margin thickness
Minimum margin thickness
101.15 mm (3.9823 in.)
100.70 mm (3.9646 in.)
5.465 to 5.480 mm (0.2152 to 0.2157 in.)
1.20 to1.60 mm (0.0470 to 0.0630 in.)
0.50 mm (0.020 in.)
Intake valve guide bush
Bush inside diameter
standard oil clearance
Maximum oil clearance
5.510 to 5.530 mm (0.2169 to 0.2177 in.)
0.025 to 0.060 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust valve guide bush
Bush inside diameter
Standard oil clearance
Maximum oil clearance
5.510 to 5.530 mm (0.2169 to 0.2177 in.)
0.030 to 0.065 mm (0.0012 to 0.0026 in.)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Valve lifter
Lifter diameter
Lifter bore diameter
Standard oil clearance
Maximum oil clearance
30.966 to 30.976 mm (1.2191 to 1.2195 in.)
31.009 to 31.025 mm (1.2208 to 1.2215 in.)
0.033 to 0.059 mm (0.0013 to 0.0023 in.)
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
133
03-13
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Connecting rod
Standard thrust clearance
Maximum thrust clearance
Standard oil clearance
Maximum oil clearance
Connecting rod bearing center wall thickness (Reference)
Bush inside diameter
Bush inside diameter (Reference)
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Mark A
Mark B
Mark C
Maximum rod out-of-alignment per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Maximum rod twist per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Cylinder block
Maximum warpage
Standard cylinder bore diameter
Maximum cylinder bore diameter
Piston
Piston diameter
Specified piston oil clearance
Piston pin hole bush inside diameter
Piston pin hole bush inside diameter (Reference)
Piston ring
Ring groove clearance
Standard end gap
Maximum end gap
Piston pin
Piston pin diameter
Piston pin diameter (Reference)
0.160 to 0.362 mm (0.0063 to 0.0143 in.)
0.362 mm (0.0143 in.)
0.024 to 0.048 mm (0.0009 to 0.0019 in.)
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
1.485 to 1.488 mm (0.05854 to 0.05858 in.)
1.489 to 1.491 mm (0.05862 to 0.05870 in.)
1.492 to 1.494 mm (0.05874 to 0.05881 in.)
22.005 to 22.014 mm (0.8663 to 0.8667 in.)
22.005 to 22.008 mm (0.8663 to 0.8665 in.)
22.008 to 22.011 mm (0.8665 to 0.8666 in.)
22.011 to 22.014 mm (0.8666 to 0.8667 in.)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
88.500 to 88.513 mm (3.4842 to 3.4848 in.)
88.633 mm (3.4895 in.)
Mark A
Mark B
Mark C
No. 1
No. 2
Oil (side rail)
No. 1
No. 2
Oil (side rail)
88.439 to 88.449 mm (3.4818 to 3.4822 in.)
0.051 to 0.100 mm (0.0020 to 0.0039 in.)
22.001 to 22.010 mm (0.8662 to 0.8665 in.)
22.001 to 22.004 mm (0.86618 to 0.86630 in.)
22.005 to 22.007 mm (0.86634 to 0.86612 in.)
22.008 to 22.010 mm (0.86645 to 0.86653 in.)
0.22 to 0.32 mm (0.0087 to 0.0126 in.)
0.50 to 0.60 mm (0.0197 to 0.0236 in.)
0.10 to 0.35 mm (0.0039 to 0.0138 in.)
0.89 mm (0.0350 in.)
1.35 mm (0.0531 in.)
0.73 mm (0.0287 in.)
Standard oil clearance
Maximum oil clearance
21.997 to 22.009 mm (0.8660 to 0.8665 in.)
21.997 to 22.000 mm (0.86602 to 0.86614 in.)
22.001 to 22.003 mm (0.86618 to 0.86626 in.)
22.004 to 22.006 mm (0.86630 to 0.86638 in.)
0.001 to 0.007 mm (0.00004 to 0.00028 in.)
0.010 mm (0.0020 in.)
Connecting rod bolt
Standard diameter
MInimum diameter
7.2 to 7.3 mm (0.283 to 0.287 in.)
7.0 mm (0.276 in.)
Mark A
Mark B
Mark C
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
134
03-14
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Crankshaft
Standard thrust clearance
Maximum thrust clearance
Thrust washer thickness
Cylinder block main journal bore diameter (Reference)
Main journal diameter
Main journal diameter (Reference)
Standard main bearing center wall thickness (Reference)
Maximum circle runout
Standard main journal oil clearance
Maximum main journal taper and out-of-round
Maximum crank pin taper and out-of-round
Crank pin diameter
Crankshaft bearing cap set bolt
Standard diameter
Minimum diameter
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Mark 0
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Mark 4
Mark 5
Mark 6
Mark 0
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Mark 4
Mark 5
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Mark 4
0.040 to 0.240 mm (0.0016 to 0.0094 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
1.930 to 1.980 mm (0.0760 to 0.0780 in.)
59.000 to 59.002 mm (2.32283 to 2.32291 in.)
59.003 to 59.004 mm (2.32294 to 2.32299 in.)
59.005 to 59.006 mm (2.32303 to 2.32307 in.)
59.007 to 59.009 mm (2.32311 to 2.32318 in.)
59.009 to 59.011 mm (2.32322 to 2.32326 in.)
59.012 to 59.013 mm (2.32330 to 2.32334 in.)
59.014 to 59.016 mm (2.32338 to 2.32346 in.)
54.988 to 55.000 mm (2.1648 to 2.1654 in.)
54.999 to 55.000 mm (2.16531 to 2.16535 in.)
54.997 to 54.998 mm (2.16523 to 2.16527 in.)
54.995 to 54.996 mm (2.16515 to 2.16519 in.)
54.993 to 54.994 mm (2.16507 to 2.16511 in.)
54.991 to 54.992 mm (2.16500 to 2.16504 in.)
54.989 to 54.990 mm (2.16489 to 2.16496 in.)
1.993 to 1.996 mm (0.07846 to 0.07858 in.)
1.997 to 1.999 mm (0.07862 to 0.07870 in.)
2.000 to 2.002 mm (0.07874 to 0.07882 in.)
2.003 to 2.005 mm (0.07886 to 0.07894 in.)
0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
0.024 to 0.048 mm (0.00094 to 0.00189 in.)
0.003 mm (0.0001 in.)
0.003 mm (0.0001 in.)
47.990 to 48.000 mm (1.8894 to 1.8898 in.)
7.3 to 7.6 mm (0.287 to 0.299 in.)
7.2 mm (0.283 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
135
03-15
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
3MZ-FE
New V-ribbed belt tension
For fan and generator
For vane pump
143 to 165 lbf
132 to 154 lbf
For fan and generator
For vane pump
80 to 132 lbf
55 to 88 lbf
Used V-ribbed belt tension
Ignition timing
w/ Terminals TC and CG of DLC3 connected
w/ Terminals TC and CG of DLC3 disconnected
Idle speed
Compression
8 to 12 BTDC @ idle
7 to 24 BTDC @ idle
650 to 750 rpm
Compression pressure
Minimum pressure
Difference between each cylinder
Valve clearance (cold)
Intake 0.15 to 0.25 mm (0.006 to 0.010 in.)
Exhaust 0.25 to 0.35 mm (0.010 to 0.014 in.)
Intake air surge tank
Maximum warpage
Intake manifold
Maximum warpage
1.5 MPa (15.3 kgf/cm2, 218 psi)
1.0 MPa (10.2 kgf/cm2, 145 psi)
100 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 15 psi)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Air intake surge tank side
Cylinder head side
Exhaust manifold
Maximum warpage
Camshaft
Maximum circle runout
Specified cam lobe height
Camshaft Journal diameter
Specified gear backlash
Specified journal thrust clearance
Specified journal oil clearance
0.50 mm (0.0196 in.)
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Intake 42.980 to 43.232 mm (1.6921 to 1.7020 in.)
Exhaust 42.960 to 43.110 mm (1.6874 to 1.6972 in.)
26.959 to 26.975 mm (1.0614 to 1.0620 in.)
0.020 to 0.300 mm (0.0008 to 0.0118 in.)
0.040 to 0.120 mm (0.0016 to 0.0047 in.)
0.025 to 0.100 mm (0.0010 to 0.0039 in.)
Cylinder head set bolt
Specified outside diameter at tension portion
Cylinder head
Maximum warpage
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
8.75 to 9.05 mm (0.3445 to 0.3563 in.)
Cylinder block side
Intake manifold side
Exhaust manifold side
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Intake valve
Specified overall length
Valve stem diameter
Minimum margin thickness
94.95 to 95.45 mm (3.7382 to 3.7579 in.)
5.470 to 5.485 mm (0.2154 to 0.2159 in.)
0.5 to 1.0 mm (0.020 to 0.039 in.)
Exhaust valve
Specified overall length
Valve stem diameter
Minimum margin thickness
94.90 to 95.40 mm (3.7362 to 3.7559 in.)
5.465 to 5.480 mm (0.2152 to 0.2157 in.)
0.5 to 1.0 mm (0.020 to 0.039 in.)
Inner compression spring
Free length
Maximum deviation
Installed tension at 33.8 mm (1.331 in.)
45.50 mm (1.7913 in.)
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
186 to 206 N (19.0 to 21.0 kgf, 41.9 to 46.3 lbf)
Valve guide bush
Bush inside diameter
Specified bush oil clearance
Cylinder head valve guide bush bore diameter
Bush diameter
Valve lifter
Lifter diameter
Lifter bore diameter
Specified oil clearance
Intake
Exhaust
STD
O/S 0.05
STD
O/S 0.05
5.510 to 5.530 mm (0.2169 to 0.2177 in.)
0.025 to 0.080 mm (0.0010 to 0.0031 in.)
0.030 to 0.100 mm (0.0012 to 0.0039 in.)
10.295 to 10.313 mm (0.4053 to 0.4060 in.)
10.345 to 10.363 mm (0.4073 to 0.4080 in.)
10.333 to 10.344 mm (0.4068 to 0.4072 in.)
10.383 to 10.394 mm (0.4088 to 0.4092 in.)
30.966 to 30.976 mm (1.2191 to 1.2195 in.)
31.009 to 31.025 mm (1.2208 to 1.2215 in.)
Standard 0.033 to 0.070 mm (0.0013 to 0.0028 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
136
03-16
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Connecting rod
Specified thrust clearance
Connecting rod thickness
Specified connecting rod oil clearance
Connecting rod bearing center wall thickness
Crankshaft
Crankshaft thrust clearance
Thrust washer thickness
Specified main journal oil clearance
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Mark 4
No. 1 and No. 4 journals
No. 2 and No. 3 journals
Cylinder block main journal bore diameter (Reference)
Mark 00
Mark 01
Mark 02
Mark 03
Mark 04
Mark 05
Mark 06
Mark 07
Mark 08
Mark 09
Mark 10
Mark 11
Mark 12
Mark 13
Mark 14
Mark 15
Mark 16
Main journal diameter
Main journal diameter (Reference)
Mark 00
Mark 01
Mark 02
Mark 03
Mark 04
Mark 05
Mark 06
Mark 07
Mark 08
Mark 09
Mark 10
Mark 11
Mark 12
Standard main bearing center wall thickness (Reference)
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Mark 4
Mark 5
Mark 6
Mark 7
Maximum circle runout
Main journal taper and out-of-round
Crank pin diameter
Maximum crank pin taper and out-of-round
0.15 to 0.35 mm (0.0059 to 0.0138 in.)
20.80 to 20.85 mm (0.8189 to 0.8209 in.)
0.038 to 0.080 mm (0.0015 to 0.0031 in.)
1.484 to 1.486 mm (0.0584 to 0.0585 in.)
1.487 to 1.489 mm (0.0585 to 0.0586 in.)
1.490 to 1.492 mm (0.0587 to 0.0587 in.)
1.493 to 1.495 mm (0.0588 to 0.0588 in.)
0.04 to 0.30 mm (0.0016 to 0.0118 in.)
1.93 to 1.98 mm (0.0760 to 0.0780 in.)
0.014 to 0.050 mm (0.0006 to 0.0020 in.)
0.026 to 0.060 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
66.000 mm (2.5984 in.)
66.001 mm (2.5985 in.)
66.002 mm (2.5985 in.)
66.003 mm (2.5985 in.)
66.004 mm (2.5986 in.)
66.005 mm (2.5986 in.)
66.006 mm (2.5987 in.)
66.007 mm (2.5987 in.)
66.008 mm (2.5987 in.)
66.009 mm (2.5988 in.)
66.010 mm (2.5988 in.)
66.011 mm (2.5989 in.)
66.012 mm (2.5989 in.)
66.013 mm (2.5989 in.)
66.014 mm (2.5990 in.)
66.015 mm (2.5990 in.)
66.016 mm (2.5990 in.)
61.000 mm (4.1016 in.)
60.999 mm (4.4015 in.)
60.998 mm (4.4015 in.)
60.997 mm (4.4015 in.)
60.996 mm (4.4014 in.)
60.995 mm (4.4014 in.)
60.994 mm (4.4013 in.)
60.993 mm (4.4012 in.)
60.992 mm (4.4012 in.)
60.991 mm (4.4012 in.)
60.990 mm (4.4012 in.)
60.989 mm (4.4011 in.)
60.988 mm (4.4011 in.)
2.486 to 2.489 mm (0.0979 to 0.0980 in.)
2.489 to 2.492 mm (0.0980 to 0.0981 in.)
2.492 to 2.495 mm (0.0981 to 0.0982 in.)
2.495 to 2.498 mm (0.0982 to 0.0983 in.)
2.498 to 2.501 mm (0.0983 to 0.0985 in.)
2.501 to 2.504 mm (0.0985 to 0.0986 in.)
2.504 to 2.507 mm (0.0986 to 0.0987 in.)
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
60.988 to 61.000 mm (2.4011 to 2.4016 in.)
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
52.992 to 53.000 mm (2.0863 to 2.0866 in.)
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
Cylinder block
Maximum warpage
Specified cylinder bore diameter
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
92.000 to 92.132 mm (3.6220 to 3.6272 in.)
Piston
Piston diameter
Specified oil clearance
91.953 to 91.967 mm (3.6202 to 3.6207 in.)
0.033 to 0.130 mm (0.0013 to 0.0051 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
137
03-17
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Connecting rod
Maximum misalignment per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Maximum rod twist per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Bush inside diameter
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
22.005 to 22.014 mm (0.8663 to 0.8667 in.)
Piston pin
Piston pin diameter
Pecified oil clearance
21.997 to 22.006 mm (0.8660 to 0.8664 in.)
0.005 to 0.050 mm (0.0002 to 0.0020 in.)
Piston ring
Piston ring groove clearance
Specified end gap
No. 1
No. 2
Oil
No. 1
No. 2
Oil (Side rail)
0.03 to 0.08 mm (0.0012 to 0.0031 in.)
0.02 to 0.06 mm (0.0008 to 0.0024 in.)
0.03 to 0.11 mm (0.0011 to 0.0043 in.)
0.30 to 0.95 mm (0.0118 to 0.0031 in.)
0.50 to 1.05 mm (0.0008 to 0.0024 in.)
0.15 to 1.00 mm (0.0012 to 0.0043 in.)
Connecting rod bolt
Specified diameter
7.0 to 7.3 mm (0.276 to 0.287 in.)
Crankshaft bearing cap set bolt
Specified diameter
7.2 to 7.6 mm (0.283 to 0.299 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
138
03-18
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
0304Q-06
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
2AZ-FE
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Engine moving control rod w/bracket x Engine moving control bracket No. 2
Part Tightened
64
653
47
Engine moving control rod bracket RH x Cylinder head
64
653
47
Engine mounting bracket RH x Cylinder head
54
551
40
Engine mounting stay No. 2 RH x Engine mounting control rod bracket No. 2
64
653
47
Engine hanger No.1 x Cylinder head
38
387
28 in.⋅lbf
Engine hanger No.2 x Cylinder head
38
387
28 in.⋅lbf
Knock sensor x Cylinder block
20
204
15
Engine oil pressure switch assy x Cylinder head
15
153
11
Water by-pass pipe No.1 x Cylinder block
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Drive shaft bearing bracket (2WD) x Cylinder block
64
653
47
V-ribbed belt tensioner assy x Timing chain cover
60
612
44
Ignition coil assy x Cylinder head
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Water inlet x Cylinder block
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Exhaust manifold converter sub-assy x Cylinder head
37
377
27
Exhaust manifold stay x Cylinder block
44
449
32
Exhaust manifold stay x Exhaust manifold converter sub-assy
44
449
32
Manifold converter insulator No. 1 x Exhaust manifold converter
12
122
9
Oil level gauge guide x Water by-pass pipe No. 1
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Intake manifold sub-assy x Cylinder head assy
30
306
22
Drive plate & ring gear x Crankshaft
98
1,000
72
Starter assy x Automatic transaxle assy
39
398
29
Engine mounting bracket RR (4WD) x Transfer
for bolt A
34
347
25
Engine mounting bracket RR (4WD) x Cylinder block
for bolt B
64
653
47
Engine mounting insulator LH x Automatic transaxle assy
95
969
70
Engine mounting insulator RH x Engine mounting bracket RH
95
969
70
Engine mounting insulator FR x Engine mounting bracket FR
87
887
64
Engine mounting insulator RR x Engine mounting bracket RR (4WD)
75
765
55
Rack & pinion power steering gear assy (4WD) x Front frame assy
70
714
52
Stabilizer bar front (4WD) x Front frame assy
19
194
14
Vane pump assy x Timing chain cover
43
438
31
Frame side plate x Front frame assy
for bolt A
86
877
63
Frame side plate x Body
for bolt B
32
326
24
Front suspension member brace rear x Front frame assy
for bolt C
86
877
63
Front suspension member brace rear x Body
for bolt D
32
326
24
35
357
26
Steering intermediate shaft
Drive plate & ring gear x Torque converter
41
418
30
Front suspension arm x Lower ball joint
127
1,295
94
Tie rod assy x Steering knuckle
49
500
36
Speed sensor front LH x Steering knuckle
8.0
82
71
Speed sensor front RH x Steering knuckle
8.0
82
71
Front axle hub LH nut x Front drive shaft
294
3,000
217
Front stabilizer link assy x Front suspension
74
755
55
Propeller shaft (4WD) x Intermediate shaft
74
755
55
Return tube x body
20
204
15
Engine mounting bracket No. 2 RH x Timing chain cover
20
204
15
52
21
530
214
38
15
Compressor and magnetic clutch x bracket
25
255
18
Air cleaner assy x Body
5.0
51
44 in.⋅lbf
Generator assy x Bracket
for bolt A
for bolt B
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
139
03-19
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
49
500
36
22
Turn 90
220
Turn 90
15
Turn 90
Stiffening crankcase assy x Cylinder block
33
337
24
W/head taper screw plug No. 1 x Cylinder block
26
265
19
Oil control valve filter x Cylinder block
30
306
22
25
255
18
79
Turn 90
806
Turn 90
58
Turn 90
Camshaft timing gear assy x Camshaft
54
551
40
Camshaft timing gear or sprocket x Camshaft
54
551
40
Camshaft bearing cap No. 1 x Cylinder head
30
306
22
Camshaft bearing cap No. 2 x Cylinder head
30
306
22
Camshaft bearing cap No. 3 x Cylinder head
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Oil pump assy x Stiffening crankcase assy
19
194
14
Chain tensioner plate x Stiffening crankcase assy
12
122
9
Oil pump drive sprocket x Oil pump
30
306
22
Chain vibration damper No. 1 x Cylinder head
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Chain vibration damper No. 1 x Cylinder block
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Chain tensioner slipper x Cylinder block
19
194
14
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
9.0
21
43
9.0
92
214
438
92
80 in.⋅lbf
15
32
80 in.⋅lbf
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Oil pan drain plug x Oil pan
25
255
18
Water pump assy x Cylinder block
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Water pump pulley x Water pump assy
26
265
19
Filler plug (Transfer)
Balance shaft housing x Stiffening crankcase assy
1st
2nd
Cylinder block water drain cock x Stiffening crankcase assy
Cylinder head x Cylinder block
1st
2nd
Timing chain guide x Crankshaft bearing cap No. 1
Timing chain cover (see page 14-68 )
for bolt A
for bolt B
for bolt C
for nut
Oil pan x Stiffening crankcase assy
Crank position sensor x Timing chain cover
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Crankshaft pulley x Crankshaft
180
1,835
133
Chain tensioner assy x Timing chain cover
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Camshaft position sensor x Cylinder head
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
11
14
11
112
143
112
8
10
8
Oil filter union (w/ oil cooler) x Stiffening crankcase assy
30
306
22
Spark plug x Cylinder head
19
194
14
Ventilation valve x Cylinder head cover
19
194
14
5.0
5.0
10
10
51
51
102
102
44 in.⋅lbf
44 in.⋅lbf
7
7
80
816
59
25
Turn 90
250
Turn 90
18
Turn 90
Cylinder head cover x Cylinder head (see page 14-41 )
Stud bolt (see page 14-92 )
for bolt A
for bolt B
for nut
for bolt A
for bolt B
for bolt C
for bolt D
Front suspension brace x Body
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod
1st
2nd
Camshaft timing oil control valve x Cylinder head
Crankshaft bearing cap x Cylinder block
Stud bolt (see page 14-105 )
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
1st
2nd
20
40
204
408
15
30
Stud bolt A
Stud bolt B
Stud bolt C
5.0
10
5.0
51
102
51
44 in.⋅lbf
7
44 in.⋅lbf
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
140
03-20
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
3MZ-FE
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Engine hanger No. 2 x Cylinder head
Part Tightened
20
204
15
Knock sensor x Cylinder block
20
204
15
Oil pressure switch assy x Cylinder block
15
153
11
Compressor mounting bracket No.1 x Cylinder block
25
255
18
Generator bracket No.1 x Cylinder block
58
591
43
Pump bracket x Cylinder head
32
326
24
Engine mounting bracket RR (2WD) x Cylinder block
64
653
47
Engine mounting bracket RR (2WD) x Front frame assy
64
653
47
Exhaust converter sub-assy x Cylinder head
49
500
36
Exhaust converter sub-assy No. 2 x Cylinder head
49
500
36
Ignition coil assy x Cylinder head cover
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Surge tank stay No. 1 x Cylinder head
20
199
14
Surge tank stay No. 2 x Intake air surge tank
20
199
14
Engine hanger No. 1 x Cylinder head
20
204
15
Engine hanger No. 1 x Intake air surge tank
20
204
15
Manifold stay No. 2 x Exhaust converter sub-assy No. 2
49
500
36
Manifold stay No. 2 x Cylinder block
49
500
36
Manifold stay x Exhaust converter sub-assy
49
500
36
Manifold stay x Cylinder head
49
500
36
34
64
347
653
25
47
Engine mounting insulator RH x Engine mounting bracket
95
969
70
Engine mounting insulator LH x Automatic transaxle assy
95
969
70
Engine mounting insulator FR x Automatic transaxle assy
87
887
64
Engine mounting insulator RR x Transverse engine engine mounting bracket
75
765
55
Rack & pinion power steering gear assy (4WD) x Front frame assy
70
714
52
Stabilizer bar front (4WD) x Front frame assy
29
296
21
Vane pump assy x Pump bracket
43
439
32
Vane pump assy x Engine mounting bracket
43
439
32
Frame side rail plate sub-assembly x Front frame assy (see page 14-149 )
for bolt A
for bolt B
85
32
867
326
63
24
for bolt A
for bolt B
for nut C
85
32
32
867
326
326
63
24
24
Compressor and magnetic clutch x Compressor mounting bracket No.1
(see page 14-149
14 149 )
for bolt
for nut
25
26
255
265
18
19
43
18
8.0
438
184
82
32
13
71 in.⋅lbf
Generator bracket No. 2 x Transverse engine engine mounting bracket
28
286
21
Intermediate shaft sub-assy
35
357
26
Battery clamp sub-assy x Body
6.0
61
53 in.⋅lbf
Exhaust manifold heat insulator No. 2 x Exhaust manifold converter
sub-assy No. 2
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Exhaust manifold heat insulator No. 3 x Exhaust manifold converter
sub-assy No. 2
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Flywheel housing under cover x Automatic transaxle assy
8.0
82
70 in.⋅lbf
Engine mounting bracket (4WD) x Cylinder block
(see page 14-149
14 149 )
Front suspension member brace rear x Front frame assy
(see page
age 14-149
14 149 )
for bolt A
for bolt B
Generator belt adjusting bar x Cylinder block (see page 14-149 )
for nut A
for bolt B
for bolt C
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
141
03-21
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Front suspension arm x Lower ball joint
127
1,295
94
Tie rod end x Steering knuckle
49
500
36
Front axle hub nut x Front drive shaft
294
2,998
217
Front stabilizer link assy x Front suspension
74
755
55
Front propeller shaft (4WD) x Intermediate shaft
74
755
55
V-bank cover x Cylinder head cover
8.0
82
70 in.⋅lbf
Engine mounting stay No. 2 RH x Engine mounting bracket
64
653
47
64
23
653
235
47
17
Front wheel
103
1,050
76
Camshaft sub-gear x Main gear
5.4
55
48 in.⋅lbf
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
8.0
20
43
82
199
438
71 in.⋅lbf
14
32
Crank position sensor x Oil pump assy
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Oil pan baffle plate x Oil pan sub-assy
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
8.0
20
82
199
71 in.⋅lbf
14
Oil strainer sub-assy x Oil pan sub-assy
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Oil pan sub-assy No. 2 x Oil pan sub-assy
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Oil pan drain plug x Oil pan sub-assy No. 2
45
459
33
Water inlet housing x Cylinder block
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
54
Turn 90
19
551
Turn 90
189
40
Turn 90
14
Oil control valve filter x Cylinder head assy
45
459
33
Cylinder head cover rear x Cylinder head assy
10
102
7
Camshaft timing gear assy (VVT-i) x Camshaft
150
1,530
111
Camshaft bearing cap x Cylinder head assy
16
163
12
Timing belt plate x Oil pump assy
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Water pump assy x Cylinder block assy
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Oil level gage guide x Cylinder block assy
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Oil filter union x Cylinder block assy
30
306
22
Timing belt idler bracket x Cylinder block assy
28
286
21
Timing belt No. 3 cover x Cylinder head assy
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Camshaft timing pulley x Camshaft
125
1,275
92
Timing belt idler sub-assy No. 2 x Timing belt idler bracket
43
438
32
Timing belt idler sub-assy No. 1 x Cylinder block assy
34
348
25
Timing belt tensioner x Oil pump assy
27
280
20
Engine mounting bracket x Cylinder block
28
286
21
Timing belt No. 2 cover x Timing belt No. 3 cover
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Timing belt No. 1 cover x OIl pump assy
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Crankshaft pulley x Crankshaft
220
2,243
162
VVT sensor No. 1 x Cylinder head assy
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Camshaft timing oil control valve assy x Cylinder head assy
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Cylinder head cover x Cylinder head assy
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Spark plug x Cylinder head assy
25
255
18
W/head straight screw plug No. 1 x Cylinder head assy
44
449
32
44
449
32
25
Turn 90
255
Turn 90
18
Turn 90
Engine moving control rod (see page
age 14
14-149
149 )
for bolt A
for bolt B
Engine rear oil seal retainer x Cylinder block
Oil pump assy x Cylinder block assy (see page 14-173 )
for bolt A
for bolt B
for bolt C
Oil pan
an sub-assy
sub assy x Cylinder block (see page
age 14-173
14 173 )
Cylinder head assy x Cylinder block assy
10 mm head
12 mm head
12 pointed head 1st
2nd
Recessed head
W/head straight screw plug No. 2 x Cylinder head assy
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod
1st
2nd
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
142
03-22
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
22
Turn 90
27
224
Turn 90
275
16
Turn 90
20
Cylinder block w/head straight screw No. 1 plug x Cylinder block
30
306
22
Cylinder block w/head straight screw No. 2 plug x Cylinder block
50
510
37
Cylinder block w/head straight screw No. 3 plug x Cylinder block
30
306
22
Water seal plate x Cylinder block
18
184
13
Cylinder block water drain cock sub-assy x Cylinder block
39
398
29
Vane pump assy x Adjusting strut
43
439
32
Generator assy x Generator bracket
58
591
43
Generator assy x Adjusting bar
18
184
13
Intake air surge tank x Intake manifold
28
286
21
Front suspension brace sub-assy upper center x Body
80
816
59
Drive plate & ring gear sub-assy x Crankshaft
83
846
61
Water outlet x Cylinder head
15
153
11
Intake manifold x Cylinder head
15
153
11
Cylinder head cover rear x Cylinder head
10
102
7
Air cleaner case x Body
5.0
51
44 in.⋅lbf
crankshaft bearing cap x Cylinder block assy
12 pointed head 1st
2nd
6 pointed head
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
143
03-23
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
EXHAUST
EXHAUST
0304F-02
SERVICE DATA
2AZ-FE
Compression spring
Free length
Exhaust pipe assy center x Exhaust pipe assy tail
42 mm (1.6535 in.)
Compression spring
Free length
Exhaust pipe assy front x Exhaust manifold converter
43 mm (1.6929 in.)
Exhaust pipe assy center x Exhaust pipe assy tail
42 mm (1.6535 in.)
Compression spring
Free length
Exhaust pipe suv-assy front No. 3 x Exhaust pipe assy center
43 mm (1.6929 in.)
3MZ-FE
Compression spring
Free length
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
144
03-24
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
EXHAUST
0304G-02
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
2AZ-FE
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Front floor heat insulator No. 3 x Body
Part Tightened
4.9
50
43 in.⋅lbf
Exhaust pipe assy front x Exhaust manifold converter sub-assy
48
489
35
Heated oxyten sensor (Bank 1, sensor 2) x Exhaust pipe assy front
44
449
35
Exhaust pipe assy center x Exhaust pipe assy front
56
571
41
Exhaust pipe assy tail x Exhaust pipe assy center
48
489
35
3MZ-FE
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Front floor heat insulator No. 3 x Body
Part Tightened
4.9
50
43 in.⋅lbf
Exhaust pipe support bracket No. 1 x Body
21
214
15
Exhaust pipe assy front x Exhaust manifold converter sub-assy (LH)
56
571
41
Exhaust pipe assy front x Exhaust pipe support bracket No. 1
21
214
15
Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 2, sensor 2) x Exhaust pipe assy front
44
449
35
Exhaust pipe sub-assy front No. 3 x Exhaust pipe assy front
56
571
41
Exhaust pipe sub-assy front No. 3 x Exhaust manifold converter sub-assy
(RH)
56
571
41
Heated oxyten sensor (Bank 1, sensor 2) x Exhaust pipe sub-assy front No.
3
44
449
35
Exhaust pipe assy center x Exhaust pipe sub-assy front No. 3
48
489
35
Exhaust pipe assy tail x Exhaust pipe assy center
48
489
35
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
145
03-25
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
COOLING
COOLING
0304H-04
SERVICE DATA
2AZ-FE
Thermostat
Valve opening temperature
Valve lift
at 95C (203F)
Radiator cap sub-assy
Standard opening pressure
Minimum opening pressure
Cooling fan
Standard amperage (80W TYPE)
Standard amperage (120W TYPE)
80 to 84C (176 to 183F)
10 mm (0.39 in.) or more
93 to 122 kPa (0.95 to 1.25 kgf/cm2, 13.4 to 17.6 psi)
78 kPa (0.8 kgf/cm2, 11.4 psi)
at 20C (68F)
at 20C (68F)
5.2 to 8.2 A
8.0 to 11.0 A
3MZ-FE
Thermostat
Valve opening temperature
Valve lift
at 95C (203F)
Radiator cap sub-assy
Standard opening pressure
Minimum opening pressure
Cooling fan
Standard amperage
80 to 84C (176 to 183F)
10 mm (0.39 in.) or more
93 to 122 kPa (0.95 to 1.25 kgf/cm2, 13.4 to 17.6 psi)
78 kPa (0.8 kgf/cm2, 11.4 psi)
at 20C (68F)
8.5 to 11.5 A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
146
03-26
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
COOLING
0304I-04
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
2AZ-FE
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Water pump x Cylinder block
Part Tightened
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Water pump x Water pump pulley
26
265
19
3MZ-FE
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Water pump assy x Cylinder block
Part Tightened
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Idler sub-assy No. 2 x Cylinder block
34
347
25
Engine mounting bracket RH x Cylinder block
54
551
40
Generator bracket No. 2 x Cylinder block
43
438
32
Water inlet x Cylinder block
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Water inlet pipe x Water inlet
20
204
15
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
147
03-27
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
LUBRICATION
LUBRICATION
0304J-03
SERVICE DATA
2AZ-FE
Oil pressure
Oil pump
Side clearance
Tip clearance
Body clearance
at idle speed
at 3,000 rpm
Standard
Maximum
Standard
Maximum
Standard
Maximum
29 kPa (0.3 kgf⋅cm2, 4.3 psi) or more
245 kPa (2.5 kgf⋅cm2, 36 psi) or more
0.030 to 0.085 mm (0.0012 to 0.0033 in.)
0.16 mm (0.0063 in.)
0.080 to 0.160 mm (0.0031 to 0.0063 in.)
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
0.100 to 0.170 mm (0.00394 to 0.00669 in.)
0.325 mm (0.01280 in.)
3MZ-FE
Oil pressure
Oil pump
Side clearance
Tip clearance
Body clearance
at idle speed
at 3,000 rpm
Standard
Maximum
Standard
Maximum
Standard
Maximum
29 kPa (0.3 kgf⋅cm2, 4.3 psi) or more
245 to 539 kPa (2.5 to 5.5 kgf⋅cm2, 36 to 78 psi)
0.03 to 0.09 mm (0.0012 to 0.0035 in.)
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
0.11 to 0.24 mm (0.0043 to 0.0094 in.)
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
0.125 to 0.162 mm (0.0050 to 0.0064 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
148
03-28
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
LUBRICATION
0304K-03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
2AZ-FE
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
15
153
11
Oil pump x Cylinder block
19
194
14
Oil pump x Oil pump cover
8.8
90
79 in.⋅lbf
Oil pump x Oil pump strainer
8.8
90
79 in.⋅lbf
Oil cooler x Union
79
800
58
Oil cooler x Cylinder block
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Oil filter x Cylinder block
Oil pressure switch x Cylinder head
17.5
178
13
Oil draon plug x Oil pan sub-assy
25
255
18
Oil pump driven shaft sprocket x Oil pump assy
30
306
22
Chain tensioner plate x cylinder block
12
122
9.0
Chain vibration danper No. 1 x Cylinder block
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Engine mounting bracket RH x Cylinder block
54
551
40
Engine mounting insulator RH x Engine mounting bracket RH Nut A
95
964
70
Engine mounting insulator RH x Engine mounting bracket RH Nut B
87
887
64
Engine mounting insulator FR x Engine mounting insurator bracket
87
887
64
Oil pan sub-assy x Stiffening crankcace assy
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
3MZ-FE
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Engine drain plug x Oil pan sub-assy
Part Tightened
45
459
33
Oil pressure switch x Cylinder block
15
153
11
Oil pump rotor set x Oil pump assembly
10
105
8.0
Oil pump relif valve x Oil pump housing
49
500
36
OIl pump cover x Oil pump housing
10
102
7.0
8.0
20
43
82
199
438
71 in.⋅lbf
14
32
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
8.0
20
82
204
71 in.⋅lbf
15
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Oil pump assembly x Cylinder block
Bolt A
Bolt B
Bolt C
Crank position sensor x Oil pump assembly
Oil pan sub-assembly x Cylinder block
10 mm head
12 mm head
Oil strainer x Main bearing cap
Oil pan sub-assembly No. 2 x Oil pan sub-assembly No. 1
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Transverse engine engine mounting bracket x PS pump bracket
Bolt A
Nut B
Bolt C
54
54
43
551
551
438
40
40
32
Engine mounting insulator RH x Engine mounting bracket
Engine mounting insulator RH x Front frame
Nut A
Nut B
95
87
969
887
70
64
Engine mounting insulator FR x Engine mounting insulator bracket
Engine mounting insulator FR x Front frame
Bolt A
Nut B
87
52
887
530
64
38
Engine moving control rod x body
64
653
47
Compressor mounting bracket No. 1 x Cylinder block
25
255
18
Timing belt idler sub-assembly No. 1 x Cylinder block
34
347
25
Timing belt idler sub-assembly No. 2 x Cylinder block
43
438
32
Compressor and magnetic clutch x Compressor mounting bracket
25
255
18
Transverse engine engine mounting bracket x Cylinder block
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
149
03-29
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
IGNITION
IGNITION
0304L-03
SERVICE DATA
2AZ-FE
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
Electrode gap
Camshaft position sensor
Resistance
Crank position sensor
Resistance
DENSO
NGK
Standard
Maximum
SK20R11
IFR6A11
1.0-1.1mm (0.039-0.043 in.)
1.3mm (0.051 in.)
at cold
at hot
835-1400Ω
1060-1645Ω
at cold
at hot
985-1600Ω
1265-1890Ω
3MZ-FE
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
Electrode gap
Crank position sensor
Resistance
Crank position sensor
Resistance
DENSO
NGK
Standard
Maximum
SK20R11
IFR6A11
1.0-1.1mm (0.039-0.043 in.)
1.3mm (0.051 in.)
at cold
at hot
835-1400Ω
1060-1645Ω
at cold
at hot
1630-2740Ω
2065-3225Ω
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
150
03-30
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
IGNITION
0304M-03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
2AZ-FE
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Spark plug x Cylinder head cover
Part Tightened
19
194
14
Ignition coil x Cylinder head cover
9.0
92
80 in.⋅lbf
3MZ-FE
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Spark plug x Cylinder head cover
Part Tightened
25
225
18.5
Ignition coil x Cylinder head cover
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
151
03-31
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
STARTING & CHARGING
STARTING & CHARGING
0304N-04
SERVICE DATA
2AZ-FE
Starter assy
Specified current
90 A or less at 11.5 V
Starter relay
Specified condition
3-5
3-5
Starter armature assy
Depth
Standard 3.1 mm (0.122 in.)
Maximum 3.8 mm (0.150 in.)
Starter commutator end frame assy
Brush length
Magnetic switch resistance
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
Standard 9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
Minimum 4.0 mm (0.158 in.)
Terminal 50 - C
Terminal 50 - Switch body
Below 1 Ω
Below 2 Ω
Segments Below 1 Ω
Commutator - Coil core 1 MΩ or higher
Starter armature resistance
Voltage regulator
Regulating voltage
Standard amperage
Generator brush holder assy
Brush length
13.2 to 14.8 V
10 A or less
Standard 10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
Minimum 4.5 mm (0.177 in.)
Generator rotor assy
Open circuit
Slip ring diameter
Resistance 2.3 to 2.7 Ω at 20C (68F)
Standard 14.2 to 14.4 mm (0.559 to 0.567 in.)
Minimum 14.0 mm (0.551 in.)
3MZ-FE
Starter assy
Specified current
90 A or less at 11.5 V
Starter relay
Specified condition
3-5
3-5
Starter armature assy
Depth
Standard 3.1 mm (0.122 in.)
Maximum 3.8 mm (0.150 in.)
Starter commutator end frame assy
Brush length
Magnetic switch resistance
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
Standard 9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
Minimum 4.0 mm (0.158 in.)
Terminal 50 - C
Terminal 50 - Switch body
Starter armature resistance
Voltage regulator
Generator brush holder assy
Brush length
Generator rotor assy
Open circuit
Slip ring diameter
Below 1 Ω
Below 2 Ω
Segments Below 1 Ω
Commutator - Coil core 1 MΩ or higher
Regulating voltage
Standard amperage
13.2 to 14.8 V
10 A or less
Standard 10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
Minimum 4.5 mm (0.177 in.)
Resistance 2.3 to 2.7 Ω at 20C (68F)
Standard 14.2 to 14.4 mm (0.559 to 0.567 in.)
Minimum 14.0 mm (0.551 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
152
03-32
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
STARTING & CHARGING
0304O-04
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
2AZ-FE
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Starter assy x Engine
37
377
27
Starter wire x Terminal 30 of starter
9.8
100
7.0
Starter drive housing assy x Magnet switch assy
7.5
76
66 in.⋅lbf
Starter commutator end frame assy x Starter drive housing assy
6.0
61
53 in.⋅lbf
Lead wire of starter yoke x Terminal C of magnet switch assy
10
102
7.0
Battery clamp x Battery clamp bolt
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
Cable x Battery terminal
3.5
36
31 in.⋅lbf
21
52
214
530
15
38
Generator wire x Generator assy
9.8
100
7.0
Generator rectifier end frame x Drive end frame assy
5.8
59
51 in.⋅lbf
Generator brush holder assy x Generator rectifier end frame
1.8
18
16 in.⋅lbf
Generator rear end cover x Generator rectifier end frame
4.6
47
41 in.⋅lbf
Starter assy
Generator assy (100A)
Generator assy x Engine
M8
M10
Retainer plate x Drive end frame assy generator
2.3
23
20 in.⋅lbf
Generator pulley x Generator rotor assy
110
1,122
81
21
52
214
530
15
38
Generator wire x Generator assy
9.8
100
7.0
Generator rectifier end frame x Drive end frame assy
5.8
59
51 in.⋅lbf
Generator brush holder assy x Generator rectifier end frame
1.8
18
16 in.⋅lbf
Generator rear end cover x Generator rectifier end frame
4.6
47
41 in.⋅lbf
Generator assy (130A)
Generator assy x Engine
M8
M10
Retainer plate x Drive end frame assy generator
2.3
23
20 in.⋅lbf
Generator pulley x Generator rotor assy
110
1,122
81
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Starter assy x Engine
37
377
27
Starter wire x Terminal 30 of starter
9.8
100
7.0
Starter drive housing assy x Magnet switch assy
7.5
76
66 in.⋅lbf
Starter commutator end frame assy x Starter drive housing assy
6.0
61
53 in.⋅lbf
Lead wire of starter yoke x Terminal C of magnet switch assy
10
102
7.0
Battery clamp x Battery clamp bolt
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
Cable x Battery terminal
3.5
36
31 in.⋅lbf
Generator assy x Generator bracket No. 2
58
592
43
Generator assy x Generator belt adjusting bar
18
184
13
Generator wire x Generator assy
9.8
100
7.0
Generator rectifier end frame x Drive end frame assy
5.8
59
51 in.⋅lbf
Generator brush holder assy x Generator rectifier end frame
1.8
18
16 in.⋅lbf
Generator rear end cover x Generator rectifier end frame
4.6
47
41 in.⋅lbf
Retainer plate x Drive end frame assy generator
2.3
23
20 in.⋅lbf
Generator pulley x Generator rotor assy
110
1,122
81
58
592
43
Generator assy x Generator belt adjusting bar
18
184
13
Generator wire x Generator assy
9.8
100
7.0
3MZ-FE
Part Tightened
Starter assy
Generator assy (100A)
Generator assy (130A)
Generator assy x Generator bracket No. 2
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
153
03-33
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
-
STARTING & CHARGING
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Generator rectifier end frame x Drive end frame assy
5.8
59
51 in.⋅lbf
Generator brush holder assy x Generator rectifier end frame
1.8
18
16 in.⋅lbf
Generator rear end cover x Generator rectifier end frame
4.6
47
41 in.⋅lbf
Retainer plate x Drive end frame assy generator
2.3
23
20 in.⋅lbf
Generator pulley x Generator rotor assy
110
1,122
81
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
154
03-68
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
03051-03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
HOOD
Part Tightened
-
-
ft⋅lbf
-
Hood × Hood hinge
13
130
10
Hood lock × Body
62 in.⋅lbf
7.0
71
FRONT DOOR
-
-
-
Door hinge × Body
23
235
17
Door hinge × Door panel
27
235
17
Door lock × Door panel
for 3 torx screw
5.0
50
45 in.⋅lbf
Door lock × Door panel
for screw
49 in.⋅lbf
5.5
56
Door lock striker × Body
23
235
17
Handle frame x Door panel
4.0
41
35 in.⋅lbf
Outside handle cover x Door panel
4.0
41
35 in.⋅lbf
Window regulator × Motor
5.4
55
48 in.⋅lbf
Window regulator × Door panel
11
112
8.0
REAR DOOR
-
-
-
Door hinge × Body
for Lower hinge
26
265
19
Door hinge × Body
for Upper hinge
17
23
235
Door hinge × Door panel
26
265
19
Door lock × Door panel
5.0
50
44 in.⋅lbf
Door lock × Door panel
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
Door lock striker × Body
23
235
17
Handle frame x Door panel
4.0
41
35 in.⋅lbf
Outside handle cover x Door panel
4.0
41
35 in.⋅lbf
Window regulator × Door panel
11
112
8.0
Window regulator × Motor
5.4
55
48 in.⋅lbf
-
-
-
Door lock × Door panel
12.5
128
9.0
Door lock striker × Body
23
235
17
Hinge x Body
19.5
199
14
Lock cylinder x Door panel
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
Outside handle x Door panel
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
BACK DOOR
BACK DOOR STAY
-
-
-
Back door Stay × Body
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Back door Stay × Door panel
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
189
03-69
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
0304S-02
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Front bumper reinforcement x Body
77
780
57
Front bumper cover x Body
5.5
55
49 in.⋅lbf
3.0
8.0
31
85
27 in.⋅lbf
71 in.⋅lbf
Rear bumper reinforcement No. 1 x Body
27
275
20
Rear bumper x Quarter panel mudguard
3.0
31
27 in.⋅lbf
Front seat outer belt shoulder anchor × Body
42.0
420
31
Rear No. 1 seat outer belt floor anchor × Body
42.0
420
31
Rear No. 2 seat outer belt shoulder anchor × Body
42.0
420
31
FRONT BUMPER
REAR BUMPER
Rear bumper cover
Bolt
Nut
ROOF HEADLINING
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
190
03-67
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
0304T-02
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Sliding roof housing assembry × Bracket
Part Tightened
8.0
82
68 in.⋅lbf
Sliding roof housing assembry × Body
5.0
51
43 in.⋅lbf
Sliding roof housing assembry × Sliding roof drive gear
5.4
55
49 in.⋅lbf
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
188
03-65
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
SEAT
SEAT
0305V-03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
8
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Seat Inner belt assy x Seat adjuster assy
42
428
31
Seatback cover bracket x Seat adjuster assy (w/ Side airbag)
5.6
57
49 in.⋅lbf
Armrest assy x Seat adjuster assy
37
377
27
36.7
375
27
Seat cushion frame No. 1 x Seat track assy inner
42
428
31
Seat cushion frame No. 2 x Seat track assy outer
42
428
31
Seatback frame lower x Seat cushion frame
42
428
31
Seat track stop plate x Seatback frame lower
18
184
13
Reclining control link x Seat track assy
42
428
31
Seatback frame assembly x Seatback frame lower
42
428
31
Seat belt assy Inner x Seatback frame lower
42
428
31
Fold seat stopper band x Seatback frame assy
9
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Seat cushion frame assy x Reclining control link
18
184
13
Seat cushion frame assy x Seatback frame lower
21
214
15
36.7
375
27
9
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Seat cushion frame No. 1 x Seat track assy outer
42
428
31
Seat cushion frame No. 2 x Seat track assy inner
42
428
31
Seatback frame lower x Seat cushion frame No. 1
42
428
31
Seatback frame lower x Seat cushion frame No. 2
120
1224
89
Seat track stop plate x Seatback frame lower
18
184
13
FRONT SEAT
Airbag sensor x Seat adjuster assy
Seat assy x Body
REAR NO. 1 SEAT LH (w/o REAR NO. 2 SEAT)
Seat assy x Body
Fold seat stopper band x Body
REAR NO. 1 SEAT RH (w/o REAR NO. 2 SEAT)
Reclining control link x Seatback frame lower
Bolt
21
214
15
Reclining control link x Seat track assy
Nut
42
428
31
Inside
Outerside
55
42
561
428
41
31
Seat belt assy Inner x Seatback frame lower
42
428
31
Seat belt assy outer center x Seatback frame assy
42
428
31
Fold seat stopper band x Seatback frame assy
9
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Seat cushion frame assy x Reclining control link
18
184
13
Seat cushion frame assy x Seatback frame lower
21
214
15
Armrest assy x Center seatback frame assy
21
214
15
Seatback hinge x Center seatback frame assy
21
214
15
Seat cushion spring No. 2 x Center seatback frame assy
21
214
15
Seatback hinge x Center seatback frame lower
21
214
15
Seat cushion spring No. 2 hinge x Center seatback frame lower
21
214
15
80 in.⋅lbf
Seatback frame assy x Seatback frame lower
Fold seat stopper band x Seatback frame assy
9
92
36.7
375
27
9
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Seat cushion frame No. 1 x Seat track assy outer
42
428
31
Seat cushion frame No. 2 x Seat track assy inner
42
428
31
Seat assy x Body
Fold seat stopper band x Body
REAR NO. 1 SEAT LH (w/ REAR NO. 2 SEAT)
Seatback frame lower x Seat cushion frame No. 1
42
428
31
Seatback frame lower x Seat cushion frame No. 2
120
1224
89
Seat track stop plate x Seatback frame lower
18
184
13
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
186
03-66
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
SEAT
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Reclining control link x Seatback frame lower
Bolt
21
214
15
Reclining control link x Seat track assy
Nut
42
428
31
Inside
Outerside
55
42
561
428
41
31
Seat belt assy Inner x Seatback frame lower
42
428
31
Seat belt assy outer center x Seatback frame assy
42
428
31
Seatback frame assy x Seatback frame lower
Fold seat stopper band x Seatback frame assy
9
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Seat cushion frame assy x Reclining control link
18
184
13
Seat cushion frame assy x Seatback frame lower
21
214
15
Armrest assy x Center seatback frame assy
21
214
15
Seatback hinge x Center seatback frame assy
21
214
15
Seat cushion spring No. 2 x Center seatback frame assy
21
214
15
Seatback hinge x Center seatback frame lower
21
214
15
Seat cushion spring No. 2 hinge x Center seatback frame lower
21
214
15
Fold seat stopper band x Seatback frame assy
9
92
80 in.⋅lbf
36.7
375
27
9
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Seat cushion frame No. 1 x Seat track assy inner
42
428
31
Seat cushion frame No. 2 x Seat track assy outer
42
428
31
Seatback frame lower x Seat cushion frame
42
428
31
Seat track stop plate x Seatback frame lower
18
184
13
Reclining control link x Seat track assy
42
428
31
Seatback frame assembly x Seatback frame lower
42
428
31
Seat belt assy Inner x Seatback frame lower
42
428
31
Fold seat stopper band x Seatback frame assy
9
92
80 in.⋅lbf
Seat cushion frame assy x Reclining control link
18
184
13
Seat assy x Body
Fold seat stopper band x Body
REAR NO. 1 SEAT RH (w/ REAR NO. 2 SEAT)
Seat cushion frame assy x Seatback frame lower
21
214
15
36.7
375
27
9
92
80 in.⋅lbf
No. 2 seat leg x No.2 seatback frame sub-assy
42
428
31
No. 2 seat leg x No.2 cushion frame sub-assy
21
214
15
No. 2 seat leg x No.2 cushion frame sub-assy
18
184
13
Seat assy x Body
37
377
27
Seat assy x Body
Fold seat stopper band x Body
REAR NO. 2 SEAT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
187
03-47
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
BRAKE
BRAKE
031IB-04
SERVICE DATA
Brake pedal height (from asphalt sheet)
150.0 - 160.0 mm (5.906 - 6.299 in.)
Brake Pedal free play
2.0 - 3.0 mm (0.079 - 0.118 in.)
Stop lamp switch clearance
0.5 - 2.6 mm (0.020 - 0.102 in.)
Pedal reserve distance from asphalt sheet at 490 N (50 kgf, 110 lbf)
More than 80 mm (3.1 in.)
Brake booster push rod to piston clearance (w/ SST)
0 mm (0 in.)
Front brake pad thickness
Standard: 11.0 mm (0.433 in.)
Minimum: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Front brake disc thickness
Standard: 28.0 mm (1.102 in.)
Minimum: 26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
Front brake disc runout
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Reae brake pad thickness
Standard: 10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Minimum: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Rear brake disc thickness
Standard: 10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Maximum: 8.5 mm (0.335 in.)
Reae brake disc runout
Maximum: 0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
168
03-48
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
BRAKE
031IC-04
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Bleeder plug
8.3
85
73 in.⋅lbf
Brake booster clevis lock nut
26
265
19
Stop lamp switch assy lock nut
17
173
13
Brake pedal support sub-assy x Brake pedal sub-assy
37
375
27
Brake master cylinder x Brake tube
15
155
11
Brake booster x Body
13
130
9
Brake pedal support sub-assy x Body
13
130
9
Brake pedal support sub-assy x Instrument panel reinforcement
20
204
15
Brake master cylinder x Brake booster
13
127
9
Wheel nut
103
1,050
76
Front brake cylinder mounting x Steering knuckle
104
1,061
77
Front brake cylinder x Front brake cylinder mounting
34
350
25
Front disc brake cylinder x Flexible hose
29
300
21
Rear disc brake cylinder mounting x Rear axle
78
799
58
Rear brake cylinder x Rear brake cylinder mounting
43
440
32
Rear disc brake cylinder x Flexible hose
29
300
21
Front speed sensor x Steering knuckle
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Front speed sensor wire harness clamp x Shock absorber
29
300
22
5.0
51
44 in.⋅lbf
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Rear speed sensor wire harness clamp x Body
5.0
51
44 in.⋅lbf
Brake actuator with bracket x Body
19
194
14
Brake actuator assy x Brake tube
15
155
11
Brake actuator x Brake actuator bracket assy
5.4
55
48 in.⋅lbf
Yawrate sensor x Body
14
143
10
Front speed sensor wire harness clamp x Body
Rear speed sensor x Rear axle
4WD:
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
169
03-44
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
TRANSFER
TRANSFER
031DF-03
SERVICE DATA
Driven pinion preload (For use with SST(s))
New bearig
Used bearing
1.1 to 1.6 N⋅m (11 to 16 kgf⋅cm, 9.7 to 14.2 in.⋅lbf)
0.9 to 1.4 N⋅m (9 to 14 kgf⋅cm, 8.0 to 12.4 in.⋅lbf)
Total preload (For use with SST(s))
New bearing
Used bearing
1.30 to 1.98 N⋅m (13.3 to 20.2 kgf⋅cm, 11.5 to 17.5 in.⋅lbf)
1.07 to 1.68 N⋅m (10.9 to 17.1 kgf⋅cm, 9.5 to 14.9 in.⋅lbf)
Ring gear
Backlash
Ring gear runout
Maximum 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
Transfer ring gear mounting case
Maximum 0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
Washer thickness LH side
Mark
AA
AB
AC
BA
BB
BC
CA
CB
CC
DA
DB
DC
EA
EB
EC
FA
FB
FC
GA
GB
GC
HA
HB
HC
JA
JB
JC
KA
KB
KC
LA
LB
0.10 to 0.15 mm (0.0039 to 0.0059 in.)
2.07 mm (0.0814 in.)
2.10 mm (0.0826 in.)
2.13 mm (0.0838 in.)
2.16 mm (0.0850 in.)
2.19 mm (0.0862 in.)
2.22 mm (0.0874 in.)
2.25 mm (0.0885 in.)
2.28 mm (0.0897 in.)
2.31 mm (0.0909 in.)
2.34 mm (0.0921 in.)
2.37 mm (0.0933 in.)
2.40 mm (0.0944 in.)
2.43 mm (0.0956 in.)
2.46 mm (0.0968 in.)
2.49 mm (0.0980 in.)
2.52 mm (0.0992 in.)
2.55 mm (0.1003 in.)
2.58 mm (0.1015 in.)
2.61 mm (0.1027 in.)
2.64 mm (0.1039 in.)
2.67 mm (0.1051 in.)
2.70 mm (0.1062 in.)
2.73 mm (0.1074 in.)
2.76 mm (0.1086 in.)
2.79 mm (0.1098 in.)
2.82 mm (0.1110 in.)
2.85 mm (0.1122 in.)
2.88 mm (0.1133 in.)
2.91 mm (0.1145 in.)
2.94 mm (0.1157 in.)
2.97 mm (0.1169 in.)
3.00 mm (0.1181 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
165
03-45
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Driven pinion bearing waasher thickness front side
Washer thickness RH side
-
TRANSFER
Mark
AA
AC
BB
CA
CC
DB
EA
EC
FB
GA
GC
HB
JA
JC
KB
LA
LC
MB
NA
NC
PB
QA
QC
1.20 mm (0.0472 in.)
1.22 mm (0.0480 in.)
1.24 mm (0.0488 in.)
1.26 mm (0.0496 in.)
1.28 mm (0.0503 in.)
1.30 mm (0.0511 in.)
1.32 mm (0.0519 in.)
1.34 mm (0.0527 in.)
1.36 mm (0.0535 in.)
1.38 mm (0.0543 in.)
1.40 mm (0.0551 in.)
1.42 mm (0.0559 in.)
1.44 mm (0.0566 in.)
1.46 mm (0.0574 in.)
1.48 mm (0.0582 in.)
1.50 mm (0.0590 in.)
1.52 mm (0.0598 in.)
1.54 mm (0.0606 in.)
1.56 mm (0.0614 in.)
1.58 mm (0.0622 in.)
1.60 mm (0.0629 in.)
1.62 mm (0.0637 in.)
1.64 mm (0.0645 in.)
Mark
AA
AB
AC
BA
BB
BC
CA
CB
CC
DA
DB
DC
EA
EB
EC
FA
FB
FC
GA
GB
GC
HA
HB
HC
JA
JB
JC
KA
KB
KC
LA
LB
LC
MA
MB
MC
NA
NB
1.47 mm (0.0578 in.)
1.50 mm (0.0590 in.)
1.53 mm (0.0602 in.)
1.56 mm (0.0614 in.)
1.59 mm (0.0625 in.)
1.62 mm (0.0637 in.)
1.65 mm (0.0649 in.)
1.68 mm (0.0661 in.)
1.71 mm (0.0673 in.)
1.74 mm (0.0685 in.)
1.77 mm (0.0696 in.)
1.80 mm (0.0708 in.)
1.83 mm (0.0720 in.)
1.86 mm (0.0732 in.)
1.89 mm (0.0744 in.)
1.92 mm (0.0755 in.)
1.95 mm (0.0767 in.)
1.98 mm (0.0779 in.)
2.01 mm (0.0790 in.)
2.04 mm (0.0803 in.)
2.07 mm (0.0814 in.)
2.10 mm (0.0826 in.)
2.13 mm (0.0838 in.)
2.16 mm (0.0850 in.)
2.19 mm (0.0862 in.)
2.22 mm (0.0874 in.)
2.25 mm (0.0885 in.)
2.28 mm (0.0897 in.)
2.31 mm (0.0909 in.)
2.34 mm (0.0921 in.)
2.37 mm (0.0933 in.)
2.40 mm (0.0944 in.)
2.43 mm (0.0956 in.)
2.46 mm (0.0968 in.)
2.49 mm (0.0980 in.)
2.52 mm (0.0992 in.)
2.55 mm (0.1003 in.)
2.58 mm (0.1015 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
166
03-46
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
TRANSFER
031DG-03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
277
378
2,820
3,855
204
279
Ring gear mount set bolt
78
790
57
Transfer case x Transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy
28
286
21
Transfer case x Transfer extension housing
26
260
19
Transfer case x Transfer & transaxle setting stud bolt
39
400
29
transfer extension housing x Transfer dynamic damper
26
260
19
Transfer case cover No.1 x Transfer case breather oil deflector
6.5
66
57 in.⋅lbf
Transfer case x Transfer case cover No.1
20
200
14
Transaxle assy x Transfer assy
69
700
51
Transfer case No.1 plug x Transfer case
49
500
36
Transfer case No.2 plug x Transfer Case
49
500
36
Transfer drain plug x Transfer case
49
500
36
Transfer gear nut (For use with SST(s))
STD
Max.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
167
03-39
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
DIFFERENTIAL
DIFFERENTIAL
031FB-03
SERVICE DATA
Carrier oil seal drive in depth
2.0 0.3 mm (0.079 0.012 in.)
Side gear shaft oil seal drive in depth
0 0.5mm (0 0.019 in.)
Companion flange vertical runout
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.) or less
Companion flange horizontal runout
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.) or less
Ring gear runout
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.) or less
Side gear backlash
0.05 to 0.20 mm (0.0020 to 0.0079 in.)
Drive pinion to ring gear backlash
0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
Drive pinion preload (at starting)
Rear
differential
New bearing
Reused bearing
1.1 to 1.7 N·m (11 to 17 kgf·cm, 9.6 to 14.8 in.·lbf)
0.6 to 0.9 N·m (6 to 9 kgf·cm, 5.2 to 7.8 in.·lbf)
Total preload (Drive pinion preload plus)
0.3 to 0.5 N·m (3 to 5 kgf·cm, 2.6 to 4.3 in.·lbf)
Side gear thrust washer thickness
mm (in.)
0.93 to 0.97 (0.0366 to 0.0382)
0.98 to 1.02 (0.0386 to 0.0402)
1.03 to 1.07 ((0.0406 to 0.0421))
1.08 to 1.12 (0.0425 to 0.0441)
1.13 to 1.17 (0.0445 to 0.0461)
1.18 to 1.22 (0.0465 to 0.0480)
1 23 to 1.27
1.23
1 27 (0.0484
(0 0484 to 0.0500)
0 0500)
1.28 to 1.32 (0.0504 to 0.0520)
1.33 to 1.37 (0.0524 to 0.0539)
1.38 to 1.42 (0.0543 to 0.0559)
mm (in.)
2.26 to 2.28 (0.0890 to 0.0898)
2.29 to 2.31 (0.0902 to 0.0909)
2.32 to 2.34 (0.0913 to 0.0921)
2.35 to 2.37 (0.0925 to 0.0933)
2.38 to 2.40 (0.0937 to 0.0945)
2.41 to 2.43 (0.0949 to 0.0957)
2.44 to 2.46 (0.0961 to 0.0969)
2.47 to 2.49 (0.0972 to 0.0980)
2.50 to 2.52 (0.0984 to 0.0992)
2.53 to 2.55 (0.0996 to 0.1004)
2.56 to 2.58 (0.1008 to 0.1016)
2.59 to 2.61 (0.1020 to 0.1028)
2.62 to 2.64 (0.1031 to 0.1039)
2.65 to 2.67 (0.1043 to 0.1051)
2.68 to 2.70 (0.1055 to 0.1063)
Drive pinion plate washer thickness
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
160
03-40
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Rear
differential
Side gear shaft plate washer thickness
-
DIFFERENTIAL
mm (in.)
2.21 to 2.23 (0.0870 to 0.0878)
2.24 to 2.26 (0.0882 to 0.0890)
2.27 to 2.29 (0.0894 to 0.0902)
2.30 to 2.32 (0.0906 to 0.0913)
2.33 to 2.35 (0.0917 to 0.0925)
2.36 to 2.38 (0.0929 to 0.0937)
2.39 to 2.41 (0.0941 to 0.0949)
2.42 to 2.44 (0.0953 to 0.0961)
2.45 to 2.47 (0.0965 to 0.0972)
2.48 to 2.50 (0.0976 to 0.0984)
2.51 to 2.53 (0.0988 to 0.0996)
2.54 to 2.56 (0.1000 to 0.1008)
2.57 to 2.59 (0.1012 to 0.1020)
2.60 to 2.62 (0.1024 to 0.1031)
2.63 to 2.65 (0.1035 to 0.1043)
2.66 to 2.68 (0.1047 to 0.1055)
2.69 to 2.71 (0.1059 to 0.1067)
2.72 to 2.74 (0.1071 to 0.1079)
2.75 to 2.77 (0.1083 to 0.1091)
2.78 to 2.80 (0.1094 to 0.1102)
2.81 to 2.83 (0.1106 to 0.1114)
2.84 to 2.86 (0.1118 to 0.1126)
2.87 to 2.89 (0.1130 to 0.1138)
2.90 to 2.92 (0.1142 to 0.1150)
2.93 to 2.95 (0.1154 to 0.1161)
2.96 to 2.98 (0.1165 to 0.1173)
2.99 to 3.01 (0.1177 to 0.1185)
3.02 to 3.04 (0.1189 to 0.1197)
3.05 to 3.07 (0.1201 to 0.1209)
3.08 to 3.10 (0.1213 to 0.1220)
3.11 to 3.13 (0.1224 to 0.1232)
3.14 to 3.16 (0.1236 to 0.1244)
3.17 to 3.19 (0.1248 to 0.1256)
3.20 to 3.22 (0.1260 to 0.1268)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
161
03-41
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
DIFFERENTIAL
031FC-04
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Drain plug
49
500
36
Filler plug
49
500
36
Breather plug
21
210
15
Companion flange x Drive pinion
See page 29-11
Companion flange x Propeller shaft
74
750
54
Differential case x Ring gear
97
985
71
Differential carrier x Side bearing cap
79
800
58
Differential carrier x Differential carrier cover
47
475
34
Rear differential support No.1 x Differential carrier assy
103
1,050
76
Rear differential support No.1 x Rear suspension member sub-assy
137
1,400
101
Differential carrier assy x Rear suspension member sub-assy
95
970
70
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
162
03-51
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
031I7-02
SERVICE DATA
U241E
Line pressure (Wheel locked)
Engine idling
D position
R position
AT stall (Throttle valve fully opened)
D position
R position
Engine stall revolution
D and R positions
N → D position
N → R position
Time lag
Engine idle speed
(A/C OFF)
N position
Drive plate runout
Torque converter runout
Max.
Max.
Differential oil seal drive in depth
LH side
RH side
Shift schedule
D position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
(Throttle valve fully closed)
2 position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
L position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
Lock-up point
3rd gear
O/D gear
373 - 412 kPa (3.8 - 4.2 kgf⋅cm2, 54 - 60 psi)
932 - 1,000 kPa (9.5 - 10.5 kgf⋅cm2, 135 - 149 psi)
931 - 1,031kPa (9.5 - 10.5 kgf⋅cm2, 135 - 150 psi)
1,768 - 1,968 kPa (18.0 - 20.0 kgf⋅cm2, 256 - 285 psi)
2,350 150 rpm
Less than 1.2 seconds
Less than 1.5 seconds
650 50 rpm
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
0 0.5 mm (0 0.020 in.)
0 0.5 mm (0 0.020 in.)
1→2
2→3
3→4
4→3
3→2
2→1
3→4
4→3
56 - 63 km/h (35 - 39 mph)
104 - 112 km/h (65 - 70 mph)
168 - 181 km/h (104 - 112 mph)
159 - 173 km/h (99 - 108 mph)
98 - 106 km/h (61 - 66 mph)
47 - 53 km/h (29 - 33 mph)
42 - 48 km/h (26 - 30 mph)
17 - 23 km/h (11 - 14 mph)
1→2
3→2
2→1
56 - 63 km/h (35 - 39 mph)
104 - 112 km/h (65 - 70 mph)
47 - 53 km/h (29 - 33 mph)
3→2
2→1
104 - 112 km/h (65 - 70 mph)
51 - 58 km/h (32 - 36 mph)
Throttle valve opening 5 %
Lock-up ON
Lock-up OFF
Lock-up ON
Lock-up OFF
97 - 105 km/h (60 - 65 mph)
95 - 102 km/h (59 - 63 mph)
63 - 70 km/h (39 - 43 mph)
61 - 67 km/h (32 - 42 mph)
U140F
Line pressure (Wheel locked)
Engine idling
D position
R position
AT stall (Throttle valve fully opened)
D position
R position
Engine stall revolution
Time lag
Engine idle speed
(A/C OFF)
Drive plate runout
Torque converter runout
Differential oil seal drive in depth
D and R position
N → D position
N → R position
N position
Max.
Max.
LH side
RH side
373 - 412 kPa (3.8 - 4.2 kgf⋅cm2, 54 - 60 psi)
932 - 1,000 kPa (9.5 - 10.5 kgf⋅cm2, 135 - 149 psi)
931 - 1,031kPa (9.5 - 10.5 kgf⋅cm2, 135 - 150 psi)
1,768 - 1,968 kPa (18.0 - 20.0 kgf⋅cm2, 256 - 285 psi)
2,650 150 rpm
Less than 1.2 seconds
Less than 1.2 seconds
700 50 rpm
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
0 0.5 mm (0 0.020 in.)
6 0.5 mm (0.236 0.020 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
172
03-52
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
1.5 0.4 mm (0.059 0.016 in.)
Extension housing oil seal drive in depth
Shift schedule
D position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
(Throttle valve fully closed)
2 position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
L position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
Lock-up point
3rd gear
O/D gear
1→2
2→3
3→4
4→3
3→2
2→1
3→4
4→3
55 - 62 km/h (34 - 39 mph)
103 - 111 km/h (64 - 69 mph)
157 - 170 km/h (98 - 106 mph)
148 - 161 km/h (92 - 100 mph)
96 - 103km/h (60 - 64 mph)
43 - 49 km/h (27 - 30 mph)
31 - 37 km/h (19 - 23 mph)
17 - 23 km/h (11 - 14 mph)
1→2
3→2
2→1
55 - 62 km/h (34 - 39 mph)
106 - 113 km/h (66 - 70 mph)
43 - 49 km/h (27 - 30 mph)
3→2
2→1
106 - 113 km/h (66 - 70 mph)
48 - 54 km/h (30 - 34 mph)
Throttle valve opening 5 %
Lock-up ON
Lock-up OFF
Lock-up ON
Lock-up OFF
157 - 170 km/h (98 - 106 mph)
148 - 161 km/h (92 - 100 mph)
76 - 83 km/h (47 - 52 mph)
71 - 78 km/h (44 - 48 mph)
U151E
Line pressure (Wheel locked)
Engine idling
D position
R position
AT stall (Throttle valve fully opened)
D position
R position
Engine stall revolution
Time lag
Engine idle speed
(A/C OFF)
Drive plate runout
Torque converter runout
Differential oil seal drive in depth
D and R positions
N → D position
N → R position
N position
Max.
Max.
LH side
RH side
372 to 412 kPa (3.8 to 4.2 kgf⋅cm2, 54 to 60 psi)
672 to 742 kPa (6.9 to 7.6 kgf⋅cm2, 97 to 108 psi)
931 to 1,031 kPa (9.5 to 10.5 kgf⋅cm2, 135 to 150 psi)
1,768 to 1,968 kPa (18.0 to 20.1 kgf⋅cm2, 256 to 285 psi)
2,100 150 rpm
Less than 1.2 seconds
Less than 1.5 seconds
650 50 rpm
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
0 0.5 mm (0 0.020 in.)
0 0.5 mm (0 0.020 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
173
03-53
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
U151E
Shift schedule (Shift lever with Multi-mode automatic transmission & Gate
shift type)
D position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
1→2
2→3
3→4
4→5
5→4
4→3
3→2
2→1
(Throttle valve fully closed)
4→5
5→4
Lock-up point
D position
5th gear
39 to 48 km/h (24 to 30 mph)
79 to 90 km/h (49 to 56 mph)
129 to 147 km/h (80 to 91 mph)
191 to 213 km/h (119 to 132 mph)
184 to 205 km/h (114 to 127 mph)
125 to 142 km/h (78 to 88 mph)
74 to 84 km/h (46 to 52 mph)
36 to 43 km/h (22 to 27 mph)
45 to 53 km/h (28 to 33 mph)
35 to 42 km/h (22 to 26 mph)
Throttle valve opening 5 %
Lock-up ON
Lock-up OFF
Lock-up ON
Lock-up OFF
Lock-up ON
Lock-up OFF
4th gear
3th gear
80 to 90 km/h (50 to 56 mph)
79 to 89 km/h (49 to 55 mph)
98 to 110 km/h (61 to 68 mph)
95 to 107 km/h (59 to 66 mph)
64 to 74 km/h (40 to 46 mph)
61 to 70 km/h (38 to 43 mph)
U151F
Line pressure (Wheel locked)
Engine idling
D position
R position
AT stall (Throttle valve fully opened)
D position
R position
Engine stall revolution
D and R positions
N → D position
N → R position
Time lag
Engine idle speed
(A/C OFF)
N position
Drive plate runout
Torque converter runout
Max.
Max.
Differential oil seal drive in depth
LH side
RH side
Shift schedule (Shift lever with Multi-mode automatic transmission & Gate
shift type)
D position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
1→2
2→3
3→4
4→5
5→4
4→3
3→2
2→1
(Throttle valve fully closed)
4→5
5→4
Lock-up point
D position
5th gear
372 to 412 kPa (3.8 to 4.2 kgf⋅cm2, 54 to 60 psi)
672 to 742 kPa (6.9 to 7.6 kgf⋅cm2, 97 to 108 psi)
931 to 1,031 kPa (9.5 to 10.5 kgf⋅cm2, 135 to 150 psi)
1,768 to 1,968 kPa (18.0 to 20.1 kgf⋅cm2, 256 to 285 psi)
2,550 150 rpm
Less than 1.2 seconds
Less than 1.5 seconds
650 50 rpm
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
0 0.5 mm (0 0.020 in.)
6.0 0.5 mm (0.236 0.020 in.)
42 to 49 km/h (26 to 30 mph)
81 to 88 km/h (50 to 55 mph)
132 to 143 km/h (82 to 89 mph)
195 to 207 km/h (121 to 129 mph)
187 to 200 km/h (116 to 124 mph)
128 to 139 km/h (80 to 86 mph)
76 to 82 km/h (47 to 51 mph)
36 to 42 km/h (22 to 26 mph)
46 to 51 km/h (29 to 32 mph)
35 to 41 km/h (22 to 25 mph)
Throttle valve opening 5 %
4th gear
3th gear
Lock-up ON
Lock-up OFF
Lock-up ON
Lock-up OFF
Lock-up ON
Lock-up OFF
83 to 90 km/h (52 to 56 mph)
81 to 87 km/h (50 to 54 mph)
100 to 107 km/h (62 to 66 mph)
97 to 104 km/h (60 to 65 mph)
65 to 72 km/h (40 to 45 mph)
62 to 68 km/h (39 to 42 mph)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
174
03-54
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
031I8-02
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
6.9
5.4
70
55
61 in.⋅lbf
48 in.⋅lbf
Control shaft lever x Control shaft
13
130
9
Shift control cable x Control shaft lever
13
130
9
64
46
37
653
470
377
47
34
27
Torque converter clutch x Drive plate
48
489
35
Flywheel housing under cover x Automatic transaxle
78
7.8
80
69 in.⋅lbf
in lbf
Engine mounting bracket FR x Transaxle
64
653
47
Oil filler tube x Transaxle
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
Control cable bracket No.1 x Transaxle
12
122
9
Control cable bracket No.2 x Transaxle
12
122
9
Oil cooler tube clamp x Control cable bracket
5.4
55
48 in.⋅lbf
Oil cooler inlet tube x Transaxle
34
347
25
Oil cooler outlet tube x Transaxle
34
347
25
Starter x Transaxle
37
377
27
Starter wire x Starter
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
Wire harness x Transaxle
13
133
10
Wire harness clamp x Transaxle
8.4
86
74 in.⋅lbf
Speed sensor (NC) x Transaxle
11
115
8
Speed sensor (NT) x Transaxle
11
112
8
Air cleaner x Air cleaner hose
5.0
51
44 in.⋅lbf
Drain plug x Oil pan
49
500
36
Transmission wire x Transaxle
5.4
55
48 in.⋅lbf
ATF temperature sensor x Valve body
6.6
67
58 in.⋅lbf
Oil pan x Transaxle
7.8
80
69 in.⋅lbf
11
6.6
110
67
8
58 in.⋅lbf
Valve body x Transaxle
11
110
8
Oil strainer x Valve body
11
110
8
Floor shift assy x Body
12
120
9
Control cable x Body
4.9
50
43 in.⋅lbf
Transfer x Transaxle (U151F)
78
800
58
Trasfer x Transfer stiffener plate RH (U151F)
34
350
25
34
350
25
70
7.0
71
62 in.⋅lbf
in lbf
Park/neutral position
osition switch
Transaxle housing x Engine block
Solenoid valve x Valve body
Nut
Bolt
A bolt
B bolt
C bolt
A B bolt
C D bolt
Engine mount bracket RR x Transfer stiffener, plate RH
Oil cooler assy x Body
Nut
bolt
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
175
03-42
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT / AXLE
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT / AXLE
031I9-02
SERVICE DATA
Propeller shaft assy swing
Maximum: 0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
Propeller shaft assy rear swing
Maximum: 0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
Intermediate shaft runout
Maximum: 0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
Intermediate shaft front flange runout
Maximum: 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
Intermediate shaft rear flange runout (horizontal direction)
Maximum: 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
Intermediate shaft rear flange runout (vertical direction)
Maximum: 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
Front axle hub bearing backlash
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Front axle hub bearing deviation
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear axle hub bearing backlash
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear axle hub bearing deviation
Maximum: 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
163
03-43
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT / AXLE
031IA-02
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
182
1,850
134
2nd
69
700
51
1st
182
1,850
134
69
700
51
Propeller shaft assy x Front flange
74
750
54
Propeller shaft assy rear x Rear differential
74
750
54
Intermediate shaft rear flange x Propeller shaft assy rear
29
296
21
Center support bearing assy No. 1 (front) x Body
37
375
27
Center support bearing assy No. 1 (rear) x Body
37
375
27
Front wheel set nut
103
1,050
76
Lower ball joint x Lower suspension arm
127
1,300
94
Tie rod end x Steering knuckle
49
500
36
Axle hub x Front drive shaft
294
3,000
217
Front disc brake caliper assy x Steering knuckle
104
1,060
77
Intermediate shaft x Center support bearing assy No. 1 (front)
1st
Loosen nut
Intermediate shaft x Center support bearing assy No. 1 (rear)
Loosen nut
2nd
Front drive shaft center bearing set bolt
32
330
24
Front speed sensor set bolt
2WD
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Flexible hose and speed sensor wire harness x Shock absorber
19
192
14
Rear wheel set nut
103
1,050
76
Speed sensor x Rear axle carrier
4WD
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Axle hub x Rear drive shaft
4WD
294
3,000
217
Rear axle carrier sub-assy x Rear disc brake caliper
78
800
58
Front stabilizer Link assy x Shock absorber
74
755
55
Shock absorber x Steering knuckle
230
2,350
170
Front axle carrier x Lower ball joint
123
1,250
91
Rear axle carrier sub-assy x Rear axle hub & bearing
75
765
55
Transfer extension housing x Transfer dynamic damper
26
260
19
Rear shock absorber x Flexible hose
19
192
14
Rear axle carrier sub-assy x Strut rod assy rear
80
816
59
Rear axle carrier sub-assy x Rear suspension arm assy No.1 LH
112
1,140
83
Rear axle carrier sub-assy x Rear suspension arm assy No.2 LH
112
1,140
83
Disc brake dust cover front x Steering knuckle
8.3
85
74 in.⋅lbf
Rear shock absorber x Rear axle carrier
180
1,840
133
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
164
03-36
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
REAR SUSPENSION
REAR SUSPENSION
031WC-01
SERVICE DATA
Toe-in (total)
Rear wheel align
alignment
No.2 lower suspension arm length difference: FF
4WD
Camber
FF
4WD
Right-left error
Rear Suspension
018’ 12’ (0.3 0.2, 3 2 mm, 0.12 0.08 in.)
1.5 mm (0.06 in.) or less
1.0 mm (0.04 in.) or less
Stabilizer link ball joint turning torque
-1 °20’ ± 45’ (-1.33° ± 0.75°)
-0 °45’ ± 45’ (-0.75° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
1.0 N⋅m (10 kgf⋅cm, 9 in.⋅lbf) or less
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
157
03-37
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
REAR SUSPENSION
031WD-01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Hub nut
103
1,050
76
Tie rod adjusting tube set nut
56
570
41
Shock absorber with coil spring x Rear axle carrier
180
1,840
133
Shock absorber with coil spring x Body
58
590
43
Support assy rear suspension x Shock absorber piston rod
49
500
36
Flexible hose set bolt
19
192
14
Skid control sensor wire set bolt
5.0
51
44 in.⋅lbf
Speed sensor set bolt
8.0
82
71 in.⋅lbf
Speed sensor wire set bolt
5.0
51
44 in.⋅lbf
Strut rod x Body
80
816
59
Strut rod x Rear axle carrier
80
816
59
Parking brake cable set bolt
39
400
29
Parking brake cable set nut
6.0
61
53 in.⋅lbf
Front side
Rear side
115
181
1,170
1,850
85
134
Rear suspension arm assy No.1 x Rear suspension member
FF
4WD
120
80
1,220
816
89
59
Rear suspension arm assy No.1 x Rear axle carrier
FF
4WD
112
112
1,140
1,140
83
83
Rear suspension arm assy No.2 x Rear suspension member
FF
4WD
120
100
1,220
1,020
89
74
Rear suspension arm assy No.2 x Rear axle carrier
FF
4WD
112
112
1,140
1,140
83
83
Stabilizer link set nut
39
400
29
Stabilizer bar bracket set bolt (FF)
19
194
14
54
19
550
194
40
14
Rear suspension member (4WD) set nut
Stabilizer bar set bolt (4WD)
Left side
Right side
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
158
03-64
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
031V3-01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part Tightened
Instrument Panel Reinforcement × Passenger Airbag
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
20
204
15
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
185
03-59
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
031WE-01
SERVICE DATA
Standard: 650 50 g (22.93 1.76 oz.)
Refrigerant charge volume
V(cooler compressor to crankshaft pulley) belt No.. 1 tension
New belt:
Used belt:
160 to 180 lbf
115 to 135 lbf
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
180
03-60
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
031WF-01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
58
18
591
183
43
13
V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
Generator installation bolt
Bolt A
Bolt B
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
Air conditioner tube assy x Cooler evaporator sub-assy No. 1
5.4
55
48 in.⋅lbf
Air conditioner unit assy x Body
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
Instrument panel reinforcement assy x Body
29
300
21
Skid control ECU assy x Reinforcement assy
5.0
50
43 in.⋅lbf
Instrument panel junction block assy x Reinforcement assy
8.4
86
74 in.⋅lbf
ECM x Reinforcement assy
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
Instrument panel brace sub-assy No. 2 x Reinforcement assy
29
300
21
Instrument panel brace sub-assy No. 1 x Reinforcement assy
29
300
21
Floor shift assy x Instrument panel brace sub-assy
12
122
9
Shift cable x Instrument panel brace sub-assy No. 2
20
200
14
Steering column assy x Reinforcement assy
21
210
15
Blower assy x Body
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
ECM x Reinforcement assy
5.5
56
49 in.⋅lbf
Magnetic clutch x Cooler compressor assy
18
183
13
Compressor and magnetic clutch x Engine
25
250
18
25
250
18
18
BLOWER ASSY
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Cooler compressor bracket x Compressor and magnetic clutch
Nut
Cooler compressor bracket x Compressor and magnetic clutch
Bolt (A)
25
250
Cooler compressor bracket x Compressor and magnetic clutch
Bolt (B)
18
184
13
Cooler refrigerant discharge hose No. 1 x Cooler compressor assy
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
Cooler refrigerant suction hose No. 1 x Cooler compressor assy
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
Magnetic clutch x Cooler compressor assy
18
183
13
Compressor and magnetic clutch x Engine
24.5
250
18
Cooler refrigerant discharge hose No. 1 x Cooler compressor assy
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
Cooler refrigerant suction hose No. 1 x Cooler compressor assy
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
Radiator support x Cooler condenser assy
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
Radiator upper support x Cross member
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
Cooler refrigerant liquid pipe A x Cooler condenser assy
5.4
55
47 in.⋅lbf
Cooler refrigerant discharge pipe A x Cooler condenser assy
5.4
55
47 in.⋅lbf
Rear heater blower fan sub-assy x Rear heater blower motor sub-assy
4.0
41
35 in.⋅lbf
Rear heater assy x Body
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
9.8
100
87 in.⋅lbf
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
REAR HEATER ASSY
Plate x Rear heater assy
Bolt (A)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
181
03-62
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
SEAT BELT
SEAT BELT
031W7-01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part Tightened
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Front seat outer belt assy RH (For upper bolt) x Body
7.5
77
66 in.⋅lbf
FRONT SEAT BELT (From August, 2003)
Front seat outer belt assy RH (For lower bolt) x Body
42
428
31
Front seat outer belt (floor anchor) x Body
42
428
31
Front seat outer belt (shoulder anchor) x Body
42
428
31
Front seat inner belt assy RH x Front seat
42
428
31
REAR NO. 1 SEAT BELT (From August, 2003)
Rear seat outer belt assy x Body (RH and LH)
42
428
31
Front seat outer belt assy (For upper bolt) x Seatback frame (Center)
7.5
77
66 in.⋅lbf
Rear seat outer belt assy (For lower bolt) x Seatback frame (Center)
42
428
31
Rear seat outer belt assy (floor anchor) x Body (RH and LH)
42
428
31
Rear seat outer belt assy (floor anchor) x Seatback frame (Center)
42
428
31
Rear seat inner belt assy RH x Seat cushion frame
42
428
31
Rear seat inner belt assy LH x Seat cushion frame
42
428
31
Rear seat inner belt assy x Body
42
428
31
REAR NO. 2 SEAT BELT (From August, 2003)
Rear seat outer belt assy (For upper bolt) x Body
7.5
77
66 in.⋅lbf
Rear seat outer belt assy (For lower bolt) x Body
42
428
31
Rear seat inner belt assy x Body
42
428
31
Rear seat lap type belt assy RH x Seat cushion frame
42
428
31
Rear seat lap type belt assy LH x Seat cushion frame
42
428
31
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
183
03-63
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
-
WIPER & WASHER
WIPER & WASHER
031WA-01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
N⋅m
kgf⋅cm
ft⋅lbf
Windshield wiper motor assy x Windshield wiper link assy
Part Tightened
5.39
55
48 in.⋅lbf
Windshield wiper link assy x Body
7.0
71
61 in.⋅lbf
FR wiper arm & blade assy RH x Windshield wiper link assy
24
245
18
FR wiper arm & blade assy LH x Windshield wiper link assy
24
245
18
Rear wiper motor assy x Body
5.5
56
48 in.⋅lbf
RR wiper arm & blade assy x Rear wiper motor assy
5.5
56
48 in.⋅lbf
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
184
05-1643
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRM-01
STEERING PAD SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends an operation signal from the steering pad switch to the radio receiver assy.
If there is an open in the circuit, the audio system cannot be operated by the steering pad switch.
If there is a short in the circuit, the same condition as that when the switch is continuously depressed occurs.
Therefore, the radio receiver assy cannot be operated by the steering pad switch, and also the radio receiver
assy itself does not function.
WIRING DIAGRAM
C16
Steering Pad SW LH
AU1
AU2
EAU
A
Spiral Cable Sub-assy
12
12
11
11
10
10
AU1
AU2
EAU
AU1
AU2
EAU
Radio Receiver Assy
12
GR
3
IL1
R
11
B
4
IL1
LG
10
L
5
IL1
GR
7
R23 SW1
8
R23 SW2
6
R23 GMD
I39166
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1833
05-1644
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(a)
(b)
R23
SW1
GMD
SW2
I40203
Disconnect the connectors from the radio receiver assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
SW1 - GMD
Do not switch position
Approx. 100 kΩ
SW1 - GMD
SEEK+ switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
SW1 - GMD
SEEK- switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
SW1 - GMD
VOL+ switch: push
Approx. 1 kΩ
SW1 - GMD
VOL- switch: push
Approx. 3.2 kΩ
SW2 - GMD
Do not switch position
Approx. 100 kΩ
SW2 - GMD
MODE switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1834
05-1645
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH LH(AU1,AU2,EAU)
C16
AU1
AU2
EAU
I39169
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the steering pad switch LH connector.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AU1 - EAU
Do not switch position
Approx. 100 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
SEEK+ switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
AU1 - EAU
SEEK- switch: push
Approx. 0.3 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
VOL+ switch: push
Approx. 1 kΩ
AU1 - EAU
VOL- switch: push
Approx. 3.2 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
Do not switch position
Approx. 100 kΩ
AU2 - EAU
MODE switch: push
Approx. 0 Ω
NG
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
(SEE PAGE 67-28 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1835
05-1646
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY - RADIO
RECEIVER ASSY)
(a)
Radio Receiver Assy:
R23
(b)
GMD
SW1
Disconnect the connectors from the spiral cable subassy and radio receiver assy R23.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
SW2
I40203
Spiral Cable Side:
A
NG
EAU AU2 AU1
I36955
Tester connection
Specified condition
SW1 - AU1
Below 1 Ω
SW2 - AU2
Below 1 Ω
GMD - EAU
Below 1 Ω
SW1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
SW2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
GMD - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
I38235
OK
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-26 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1836
05-1651
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRO-01
AMP MUTE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (FROM RADIO RECEIVER ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends the signal to the stereo component amplifier to mute the noise. Because of that, the noise
produced by changing the sound source ceases.
In addition, this circuit is used to mute the sound when the navigation system performs voice guide.
If the vehicle is equipped with a navigation system, normal audio sound will cease, and only voice guidance
will be heard from the driver’s side speaker when voice guides are given.
If there is an open in the circuit, noise can be heard from the speaker when changing the sound source.
If there is a short in the circuit, even though the stereo component amplifier assy is normal, no sound or only
extremely small sound can be produced.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio Receiver Assy
Stereo Component Amplifier Assy
12
MUTE S22
BR
5
IR2
BR
7
R4 MUTE
I36622
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1841
05-1652
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER ASSY
(a)
S22
Measure the voltage according to the value in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specification
MUTE - Body ground
Turn ignition switch to
ACC, Audio system is
playing → Changing
Above 3.5 V → Below 1 V
NG
MUTE
Go to step 2
I39177
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(RADIO RECEIVER ASSY - STEREO
COMPONENT AMPLIFIER ASSY)
(a)
Radio Receiver Assy:
(b)
R4
MUTE
Disconnect the connectors from the radio receiver assy
and stereo component amplifier assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
MUTE - MUTE
Always
Below 1 Ω
MUTE - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Stereo Component Amplifier Assy:
S22
I39175
I39178
MUTE
NG
I40341
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1842
05-1653
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY (SEE PAGE 67-6 )
Replace the radio receiver assy and check if it operates normally.
OK: The radio receiver assy operates normally
OK
NORMAL OPERATION
NG
REPLACE STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER ASSY (SEE PAGE 67-20 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1843
05-1657
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRQ-01
SPEAKER CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the vehicle has a built-in type amplifier, a sound signal is sent from the radio receiver assy to
the speakers via the ”standard type” circuit.
When the vehicle has a separate type amplifier, a sound signal from the radio receiver assy is amplified
by the stereo component amplifier and then transmitted to the speaker via the ”JBL type”.
If there is a short in this circuit, the stereo component amplifier assy detects it and stops output to the speaker.
Thus sound can not be heard from the speaker even if there is no malfunction in the stereo component amplifier assy or speaker.
JBL Type:
When a short in the speaker circuit is detected, all sound output is stopped.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1847
05-1658
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Standard type:
R
F10
Front No.1
Speaker Assy LH
1
2
W
Y
F11
Front No.1
Speaker Assy RH
R9
Rear Speaker
Assy LH
R10
Rear Speaker
Assy RH
1
2
B
2
V
6
IB1
T12
Front No.2 Speaker Assy RH
7
3
1
LG
IN1
2
4
P
10
IF3
P
G
20
IF3
V
6
R3 FL-
Y
1
IL1
LG
1
R3 FR+
L
6
IN1
R
10
IL1
L
5
R3 FR-
5
BB1
L
1
BH1
Y
10
IR1
B
2
R2 RL+
W
10
BB1
Y
10
BH1
R-Y
20
IR1
Y
6
R2 RL-
R
5
BC1
LG
1
IR1
R
1
R2 RR+
W
10
BC1
L
11
IR1
W
3
R2 RR-
1
2
4
Radio Receiver Assy
2
R3 FL+
R
1
2
T11
Front No.2 Speaker Assy LH
7
1
3
P
IB1
I30205
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1848
05-1659
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
JBL type:
Stereo Component
Amplifier Assy
T11 Front No.2 Speaker Assy LH
7
R
P
P
IB1
1
1
3
F10
Front No.1
Speaker Assy LH
SLD
9
S23 FL-
LG
1
S23 FR+
10
IL1
B
11
IR1
L
8
S23 FR-
6
IB1
B
(*1)
L
6
IN1
R
5
BB1
L
1
BH1
GR
4
S23 RL+
W
10
BB1
Y
10
BH1
LG
11
S23 RL-
R
5
BC1
R
3
S23 RR+
W
10
BC1
G
10
S23 RR-
2
1
R
1
2
MUTE
R-Y
1
IR1
R10
Rear Speaker
Assy RH
RR+
20
IR1
G
2
RL+
2
S23 FL+
1
IL1
R9
Rear Speaker
Assy LH
FR+
Y
T12 Front No.2 Speaker Assy RH
7
LG
Y
Y
IN1
1
1
3
2
4
FL+
10
IR1
20
IF3
V
W
4
2 B
R4
Radio Receiver Assy
G
(*1)
G
2
F11
Front No.1
Speaker Assy RH
10
IF3
(Shielded)
(Shielded)
B
3
IR2
W
4
IR2
W
R
13
IR2
R
9
8
19
12
IR2
5
IR2
16
IR2
G
18
BR
7
10
B
G
BR
5
S22 F.L
6
S22 F.R
13
S22 R.L
14
S22 R.R
12
S22 MUTE
*1: w/o Navigation System
I39172
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1849
05-1660
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK TYPE
HINT:
If the radio receiver assy is JBL type, ”JBL” is indicated on its surface.
(a) Choose type to be inspected.
Type
Go to step
Standard type
A
JBL type
B
B
Go to step 6
A
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(RADIO RECEIVER ASSY - SPEAKER
ASSY)
(a)
Radio Receiver Assy:
(b)
R3
R2
FR+
RL+
FL+
RR+
FLFR-
RL-
RR-
Wire Harness Side:
(Front No.1 Speaker Assy)
(Rear Speaker Assy)
Disconnect the connectors from the radio receiver assy
and speakers.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
I40177
F10
F11
R9
R10
I38233
Wire Harness Side:
(Front No.2 Speaker Assy)
T11
Tester connection
Specified condition
FL+ - 1 (Front No.1 speaker assy LH)
Below 1 Ω
FL- - 2 (Front No.1 speaker assy LH)
Below 1 Ω
FR+ - 1 (Front No.1 speaker assy RH)
Below 1 Ω
FR- - 2 (Front No.1 speaker assy RH)
Below 1 Ω
FL+ - 1 (Front No.2 speaker assy LH)
Below 1 Ω
FL- - 2 (Front No.2 speaker assy LH)
Below 1 Ω
FR+ - 1 (Front No.2 speaker assy RH)
Below 1 Ω
FR- - 2 (Front No.2 speaker assy RH)
Below 1 Ω
RL+ - 1 (Rear speaker assy LH)
Below 1 Ω
RL- - 2 (Rear speaker assy LH)
Below 1 Ω
RR+ - 1 (Rear speaker assy RH)
Below 1 Ω
RR- - 2 (Rear speaker assy RH)
Below 1 Ω
FL+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
FL- - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
FR+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
FR- - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
RL+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
RL- - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
RR+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
RR- - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T12
NG
I38999
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1850
05-1661
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECT FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSY
(a)
Resistance check
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the speaker.
NOTICE:
The speaker should not be removed for checking.
Standard: 4 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSY (SEE
PAGE 67-10 )
OK
4
(a)
INSPECT FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSY
Check that malfunction disappears when another speaker in a good condition is installed.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
HINT:
Connect all the connectors to the speakers.
When there is a possibility that either right or left front speaker is defective, inspect by interchanging
the right one and the left one.
OK
REPLACE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSY (SEE
PAGE 67-1 1)
NG
5
INSPECT REAR SPEAKER ASSY
(a)
Resistance check
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the speaker.
NOTICE:
The speaker should not be removed for checking.
Standard: 8 Ω
NG
REPLACE REAR SPEAKER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-12 )
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1851
05-1662
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER ASSY SPEAKER ASSY)
(a)
Stereo Component Amplifier Assy:
(b)
S23
RR+
Disconnect the connectors from the stereo component
amplifier assy and speakers.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
FL+
RL+
Tester connection
Specified
condition
FL+ - 1 (Front No.1 speaker assy LH)
Below 1 Ω
FR+
FRRL-
RR-
FL-
I39179
Front No.1 Speaker Assy:
Rear Speaker Assy:
F10
F11
R9
R10
FL- - 2 (Front No.1 speaker assy LH)
Below 1 Ω
FR+ - 1 (Front No.1 speaker assy RH)
Below 1 Ω
FR- - 2 (Front No.1 speaker assy RH)
Below 1 Ω
FL+ - 1 (Front No.2 speaker assy LH)
Below 1 Ω
FL- - 2 (Front No.2 speaker assy LH)
Below 1 Ω
FR+ - 1 (Front No.2 speaker assy RH)
Below 1 Ω
FR- - 2 (Front No.2 speaker assy RH)
Below 1 Ω
RL+ - 1 (Rear speaker assy LH)
Below 1 Ω
RL- - 2 (Rear speaker assy LH)
Below 1 Ω
RR+ - 1 (Rear speaker assy RH)
Below 1 Ω
RR- - 2 (Rear speaker assy RH)
Below 1 Ω
FL+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
FL- - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
FR+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
FR- - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
RL+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
I38233
Front No.2 Speaker Assy:
T11
T12
NG
I38999
RL- - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
RR+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
RR- - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
7
INSPECT FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSY
(a)
Resistance check
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the speaker.
NOTICE:
The speaker should not be removed for checking.
Standard: 2 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-10 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1852
05-1663
DIAGNOSTICS
8
(a)
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECT FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSY
Check that malfunction disappears when another speaker in a good condition is installed.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
HINT:
Connect the connector to the speaker.
When there is a possibility that either right or left front speaker is defective, inspect by interchanging
the right one and the left one.
OK
REPLACE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-1 1)
NG
9
INSPECT REAR SPEAKER ASSY
(a)
Resistance check
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the speaker.
NOTICE:
The speaker should not be removed for checking.
Standard: 2 Ω
NG
REPLACE REAR SPEAKER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-12 )
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1853
05-1669
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05CL5-04
AMP SOUND SIGNAL CIRCUIT (RADIO RECEIVER ASSY - AMP)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The radio receiver assy sends a sound signal to the stereo component amplifier assy through this circuit.
The sound signal that has been sent is amplified by the stereo component amplifier assy, and then is sent
to the speaker.
If there is an open or short in the circuit, sound can not be heard from the speaker even if there is no malfunction in the stereo component amplifier assy or speaker.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier Assy
(Shielded)
R.R
14
S22
R.L
13
S22
6
F.R S22
5
F.L
S22
G
(*1)
R
(*1)
W
(*1)
B
(*1)
Radio Receiver Assy
16
IR2
(Shielded)
12
IR2
G
(*1)
13
IR2
R
(*1)
4
IR2
W
(*1)
3
IR2
B
(*1)
10
R4 SLD
18
R4 RR+
19
R4
RL+
8
R4 FR+
9
R4
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
FL+
I39182
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1859
05-1670
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(RADIO RECEIVER ASSY - STEREO
COMPONENT AMPLIFIER ASSY)
(a)
Radio Receiver Assy:
(b)
R4
FR+
FL+
Disconnect the connectors from the radio receiver assy
and stereo component amplifier assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
SLD
RL+
RR+
I39175
Stereo Component Amplifier Assy:
S22
Tester connection
Specified condition
FL+ - F.L
Below 1 Ω
FR+ - F.R
Below 1 Ω
RL+ - R.L
Below 1 Ω
RR+ - R.R
Below 1 Ω
FL+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
FR+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
RL+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
RR+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
F.L
F.R
NG
R.R
R.L
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
I39178
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1860
05-1671
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRS-03
RSE SOUND SIGNAL CIRCUIT (MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER
SUB-ASSY - RADIO RECEIVER ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multi-display controller sub-assy sends a sound signal to the radio receiver assy through this circuit.
The sound signal that has been sent is amplified by the stereo component amplifier assy, and then is sent
to the speaker.
If there is an open or short in the circuit, sound can not be heard from the speaker even if there is no malfunction in the stereo component amplifier assy or speaker.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio Receiver Assy
Multi-display Controller Sub-Assy
11
SG1 R29
7
L- R29
8
L+ R29
9
R- R29
10
R+ R29
(Shielded)
G
(*1)
R
(*1)
W
(*1)
B
(*1)
8
IP1
(Shielded)
7
IP1
5
R22 L-
G
(*1)
6
IP1
4
R22 L+
R
(*1)
5
IP1
3
R22 R-
W
(*1)
4
IP1
2
R22 R+
B
(*1)
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
I40722
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1861
05-1672
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER
SUB-ASSY - RADIO RECEIVER ASSY)
(a)
Radio Receiver Assy:
(b)
R4
R+
Disconnect the connectors from the radio receiver assy
and multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
L-
RL+
I39175
Multi-display Controller Sub-Assy:
R29
NG
SG1
R+
Tester connection
Specified condition
R+ - R+
Below 1 Ω
R- - R-
Below 1 Ω
L+ - L+
Below 1 Ω
L- - L-
Below 1 Ω
R+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
R- - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
L+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
L- - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
LR-
L+
I34639
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1862
05-1654
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRP-03
MUTE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (FROM MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER
SUB-ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The radio receiver assy controls the volume according to the LMUT signal from the multi-display controller
sub-assy .
The LMUT signal is send to reduce noise and pop sound when switching mode, etc.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display Controller
Sub-Assy
Radio Receiver Assy
6
MUTE R22
P
(*1)
20
IP1
V
(*1)
12
R29 LMUT
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
I34950
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1844
05-1655
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(a)
R4
Measure the voltage according to the value in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specification
MUTE - Body ground
Turn ignition switch to
ACC, RSE system is playing → Changing
Above 3.5 V → Below 1 V
MUTE
NG
Go to step 2
I39180
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE PAGE
05-1632 )
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(RADIO RECEIVER ASSY - MULTI-DISPLA Y
CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY)
Radio Receiver Assy:
(a)
R4
(b)
MUTE
Disconnect the connectors from the radio receiver assy
and multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
MUTE - LMUT
Always
Below 1 Ω
MUTE - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
I39175
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
R29
LMUT
NG
I34639
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1845
05-1656
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECT MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY
(a)
(b)
R29
LMUT
I34639
Disconnect the connectors from the multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
LMUT - Body ground
Turn ignition switch to
ACC
Above 3.5 V
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 67-23 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1846
05-1638
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRK-01
POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT (STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides the power to the stereo component amplifier assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio Receiver Assy
3
AMP+ R4
Stereo Component Amplifier Assy
1
P
S22 AMP+
J18
J/C
2
G
G
S22 ACC
A
A
6
IR2
V
Passenger Side J/B
Y
2
4E
L-B
4
3C
8
4D
W
14
IO1
5
3C
R-Y
1
IR2
Center J/B
2
IL1
20
IK3
LG
L-Y
4
2C
Engine Room J/B
RAD No.1
D.C.C
B
RAD No.2
2
1C
1
1A
AM1
6
1C
1
1
2I
I15
Ignition SW
Instrument Panel J/B
1
1H
7
S23 +B
R-Y
L
3
ACC AM1
2
W
2
F7
Fusible Link Block
ALT
2
W
3
W-B
W
FL MAIN
A
1
W-B
A
Battery
12
S23 GND
J19
J/C
A W-B
BB
BF
I39185
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1828
05-1639
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(a)
R4
AMP+
Measure the voltage according to the value in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AMP+ - Body ground
Radio receiver assy ON
10 to 14 V
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY (SEE PAGE
67-6 )
I39180
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(RADIO RECEIVER ASSY - STEREO
COMPONENT AMPLIFIER ASSY)
Radio Receiver Assy:
(a)
R4
(b)
AMP+
Disconnect the connectors from the radio receiver assy
and stereo component amplifier assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AMP+ - AMP+
Always
Below 1 Ω
AMP+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
I39175
Stereo Component Amplifier Assy:
S22
AMP+
NG
I39178
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1829
05-1640
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECT STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER ASSY(+B, ACC, GND)
(a)
(b)
S23
S22
ACC
+B
GND
(c)
I39176
Disconnect the connectors from the stereo component
amplifier assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Measure the voltage according to the values in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
+B - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1830
05-1680
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05ASI-06
CD CANNOT BE EJECTED
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PRESS ”EJECT” AND CHECK OPERATION
(a)
Press ”EJECT”and check the operation.
(1) Press the CD EJECT switch of the radio receiver assembly for 2 seconds or more to see if the
CD is ejected.
OK: CD is ejected.
Reference:
If the CD is not ejected, bring the vehicle in for repair.
Do not attempt to remove it by force.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
2
(a)
CHECK IF A PROPER CD IS INSERTED
Check that a normal audio CD is inserted.
(1) Check in what conditions the sound skipping occurs.
OK: Driving on a bad road.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
3
(a)
REPLACE CD WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
Replace the CD with another and recheck.
(1) Check the installation condition of the radio receiver assembly.
OK: Installed properly.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
CD FAULTY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1870
05-1678
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05ASH-07
CD CANNOT BE INSERTED OR IS EJECTED RIGHT AFTER
INSERTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK IF A NORMAL CD IS INSERTED
(a)
Check if a normal CD is inserted.
(1) Make sure that the CD is a normal audio CD, and that there is no deformation, flaw, stain, burr
or other defects on the CD.
OK: Normal audio CD.
Reference:
Translucent or oddly-shaped CD cannot be played.
Computer CD-ROMs (even those with music) and CD-R discs cannot be played.
Playing an 8 cm CD does not require an adapter.
NG
CD FAULTY
OK
2
(a)
CHECK IF A CD IS INSERTED PROPERLY
Check if a CD is inserted properly.
(1) Check whether or not the CD is inserted upside down.
OK: Not upside down.
NG
SET DISC CORRECTLY
OK
3
DISC CLEANING
(a)
Disc cleaning
(1) If the disc gets dirty, clean the disc by wiping the surface from the center to outside in the radial directions with a soft cloth.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or anti-static preservative.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
E50013
OK
DISC DIRTY
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1868
05-1679
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
REPLACE CD WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
Replace the CD with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the CD with another normal one to see if the same trouble occurs again.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
CD FAULTY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1869
05-1682
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
055M0-11
CD SOUND SKIPS
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
DISC CLEANING
(a)
Disc cleaning
(1) If the disc gets dirty, clean the disc by wiping the surface from the center to outside in a radial direction
with a soft cloth.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or anti-static preservative.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
E50013
OK
DISC DIRTY
NG
2
(a)
REPLACE CD WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
Replace the CD with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the CD with another normal one to see if the same trouble occurs again.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
OK
CD FAULTY
NG
3
(a)
CHECK WHEN THIS HAPPENS
Check when this happens.
(1) Check under what conditions (places) noise occurs.
OK: Driving on a bumpy road.
OK
Go to step 5
NG
4
(a)
COMPARE IT WITH ANOTHER CAR OF SAME MODEL
Compare it with another vehicle of the same model.
(1) Compare it with the vehicle of the same type which does not have a trouble to see if there is any
difference in the CD sound.
OK: No difference found.
OK
SETTING
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1872
05-1683
DIAGNOSTICS
5
(a)
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
CHECK OF RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY INSTALLATION
Check the radio receiver assembly installation condition.
(1) Check that the radio receiver assembly is installed properly.
OK: Installed properly.
NG
INSTALL THE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
PROPERLY
OK
6
DID TEMPERATURE IN CABIN CHANGE RAPIDLY?
(a)
Did the temperature in the cabin change rapidly?
(1) Check whether or not the rapid temperature change occurred in the cabin.
OK: The rapid temperature change occurred.
Reference:
The rapid temperature change creates condensation inside the CD player, which may prevent the CD from
being played.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
CONDENSATION DUE TO TEMPERATURE CHANGE (LEAVE IT AS IT IS FOR A WHILE BEFORE
USING)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1873
05-1647
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRN-01
ILLUMINATION CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the light control switch is in the TAIL or HEAD position, the TAILLIGHT relay activates and supplies
power to illuminate the radio receiver assy panel.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1837
05-1648
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
C11
Combination Meter Assy
ILL
5
3F
2
3G
W
3
3D
9
3F
LG
10
13
3F
8
3I
B
7
12
V
22 W-B
12
IK3
Radio Receiver Assy
Center J/B
V
3E
12
3A
Passenger Side J/B
6
11
4H
4D
V
12 5
R4 R2 ILL(*1) (*2)
W-B
2
R4
G
10
R3 ILL+
(*1) (*2)
11
IL2
Engine Room J/B
3
2A
R
DOME
1
2I
D.C.C
W
Instrument Panel J/B
7
1K
4
1J
O
Taillight System
PANEL TAILLIGHT Relay 1
1A
3
5
2
B
1
F7
Fusible Link Block
W
1
ALT
2
3
FL MAIN
Battery
IB
*1:JBL Type
*2:Standard Type
I40214
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1838
05-1649
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK SYSTEM
Turn the light control switch to the TAIL or HEAD position.
Check if other displays or indicators such as the A/C indicator come on.
OK: Other displays or indicators come on.
NG
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
(SEE PAGE 05-1868 )
OK
2
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY(ILL+)
(a)
(b)
Standard Type:
R3
Disconnect the connector from the radio receiver assy.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
ILL+ - Body ground
Light SW TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
ILL+
I39174
JBL Type:
R4
ILL+
NG
I39175
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1839
05-1650
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(COMBINATION METER ASSY - RADIO
RECEIVER ASSY)
(a)
Combination Meter Assy:
(b)
C11
Disconnect the connectors from the combination meter
assy and radio receiver assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
ILL
Tester connection
Specified condition
ILL - ILL-
Below 1 Ω
ILL - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
I40182
Radio Receiver Assy
Standard Type:
R2
ILL-
I40213
Radio Receiver Assy:
JBL Type:
R4
ILL-
NG
I39175
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1840
05-1688
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRU-02
AVC-LAN CIRCUIT (MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Each unit of the radio receiver system connected to AVC-LAN (communication bus) communicates by transferring the signals from each switch.
When +B short and GND short occur in this AVC-LAN, radio receiver system will not function normally as
communication is discontinued.
In AVC-LAN, radio receiver assy becomes the communication master, and the radio receiver assy has
enough resistance necessary for transmitting the communication.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy
31
TX+ R29
30
TX- R29
Radio Receiver Assy
LG
(*1)
GR
(*1)
9
IP1
19
IP1
Y
(*1)
L
(*1)
9
R23 TX1+
10
R23 TX1-
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
I39199
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1878
05-1689
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(a)
R23
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
TX1+ - TX1-
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TX1TX1+
I40222
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER
SUB-ASSY - RADIO RECEIVER ASSY)
(a)
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
(b)
R29
TX+
TXI34639
Disconnect the connectors from the multi-display controller sub-assy R29 and radio receiver assy R23.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
TX+ - TX1+
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX- - TX1-
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
TX- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Radio Receive Assy:
R23
TX1+
TX1-
NG
I40203
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1879
05-1664
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRR-02
SPEAKER CIRCUIT (DRIVER SIDE SPEAKER)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the vehicle is equipped with the navigation system, a sound signal for the driver’s side is sent from
the stereo component amplifier to the driver’s side speaker via the navigation ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component
Amplifier Assy
Navigation ECU
2
FL+ S23
9
S23
FL-
F10
Front No.1
Speaker Assy
LH
Y
10
IR1
LG
(*1)
R-Y
20
IR1
R
(*1)
P
7
IB1
P
10
IF3
2 V
6
IB1
G
20
IF3
R
1
3
2
W 4
1
1
N3
10
N3
AUI-
2
N3 AUO+
G
(*1)
B
(*1)
AUI+
11
N3 AUO-
T11
Front No.2 speaker
Assy LH
*1: w/ Navigation System
I40199
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1854
05-1665
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK NAVIGATION VOICE GUIDANCE
Check if navigation voice guidance is heard from the speaker on the driver side.
OK: Voice guidance is heard.
OK
Go to step 8
NG
2
(a)
CHECK SETTING(THE VOLUME OF THE NAVIGATION VOICE SOUND)
Check that ”OFF” is not selected.
OK: OFF is not selected.
NG
USING VOICE ADJUSTMENT SWITCH, TURN
THE VOICE GUIDANCE VOLUME UP
OK
3
(a)
INSPECT SYSTEM
Check the system.
(1) Check if sound is heard from speakers.
Symptom
Proceed to
No sound is heard from both speakers
A
No sound is heard from front No.1 speaker assy
B
No sound is heard from front No.2 speaker assy
Replace front No.2 speaker assy (see page 67-11)
B
Go to step 6
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1855
05-1666
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(NAVIGATION ECU - FRONT NO. 2
SPEAKER ASSY)
(a)
Navigation ECU:
(b)
N3
AUO+
AUO-
Disconnect the connectors from the navigation ECU and
speaker.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AUO+ - 1
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUO- - 2
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUO+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
AUO- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Wire Harness Side:
Front No.2 Speaker Assy
NG
I40178
I38999
I40553
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
5
(a)
INSPECT FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSY
Check that malfunction disappears when another speaker in a good condition is installed.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
HINT:
Connect all the connectors to the speakers.
When there is a possibility that either right or left front speaker is defective, inspect by interchanging
the right one and the left one.
OK
REPLACE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-1 1)
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1856
05-1667
DIAGNOSTICS
6
AUDIO SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSY - FRONT
NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side:
Front No.2 Speaker Assy
(b)
Wire Harness Side:
Front No.1 Speaker Assy
I38999
I38233
-
Disconnect the connectors from the front No.2 speaker
assy and front No.1 speaker assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
3 (Front No.2 speaker
Assy) - 1 (Front No.1
speaker Assy)
Always
Below 1 Ω
4 (Front No.2 speaker
Assy) - 2 (Front No.1
speaker Assy)
Always
Below 1 Ω
3 (Front No.2 speaker
Assy) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
4 (Front No.2 speaker
Assy) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
I40554
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
7
INSPECT FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSY
(a)
Resistance check
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the speaker.
NOTICE:
The speaker should not be removed for checking.
Standard: 4 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-10 )
OK
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU (SEE PAGE 67-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1857
05-1668
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(NAVIGATION ECU - STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER ASSY)
(a)
Navigation ECU:
(b)
N3
AUI+
AUIStereo Component Amplifier Assy:
S23
I40178
I39179
FL-
FL+
Disconnect the connectors from the navigation ECU and
stereo component amplifier assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AUI+ - FL+
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUI- - FL-
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUI+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
AUI- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
I40555
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
9
INSPECT NAVIGATION ECU
(a)
(b)
N3
AUO+
AUO-
AUI+
AUII40178
Disconnect the connector from the navigation ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AUI+ - AUO+
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUI- - AUO-
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
(SEE PAGE 67-9 )
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1858
05-1674
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
055M1-10
NOISE OCCURS
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK OF SPEAKER INSTALLATION
Check the speaker installation condition.
(1) Check that each speaker is securely installed.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
HINT:
The radio is equipped with a noise prevention system that blocks only excessively loud noise. If loud noise
occurs, check whether or not the ground on the antenna installation part and the proper noise-prevention
equipment are all installed, and whether or not there is improper wiring.
Condition in which noise occurs
Noise type
Depressing the acceleration pedal increases the noise, and stopping the
engine stops the noise immediately.
Alternator noise
Noise occurs during A/C or the heater operation.
Blower motor noise
Rapid acceleration during the drive on an unpaved road or after the ignition
switch is turned on makes noise.
Fuel pump noise
Pressing and then releasing the horn switch, and keeping pressing the horn
switch makes noise.
Horn noise
Quiet noise is heard while the engine is running, but stops with the engine.
Ignition noise
Noise occurs in turn with the blink of the turn signal flash.
Flasher noise
Noise occurs during window washer operation.
Washer noise
Noise occurs while the engine is running, and it continues even after the engine is stopped.
Water temperature sensor noise
Noise occurs during wiper operation.
Wiper noise
Noise occurs when the brake pedal is depressed.
Stop light switch noise
Others
Static electricity on the vehicle
HINT:
Identify the condition in which the noise occurs, and check the noise filter on the related part.
Make sure first that there is no noise from outside. Failing to do so makes the noise occurrence source
detection difficult and leads to misdiagnosis.
The noise should be removed in descending order of loudness.
NG
INSTALL IT PROPERLY
OK
IDENTIFICATION OF NOISE SOURCE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1864
05-1634
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRJ-01
POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT (RADIO RECEIVER ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides the power to the radio receiver assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Standard type:
Engine Room J/B
Radio Receiver Assy
1
D.C.C
RAD No.1
4
2C
2I
20
IK3
L-Y
LG
2
IL1
L-B
4
R3
BU+B
3
R3
ACC+B
Center J/B
13
3A
V
GR
Instrument Panel J/B
I15
Ignition SW
2 AM1
9
3I
2
1C
L
ACC 3
6
1C
W
RAD No. 2
3
1K
AM1
1
1A
2
1
W
3
FL MAIN
Battery
W
ALT
1
2
B
BR
F7 Fusible Link
Block
7
R3
GND
IB
I30203
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1824
05-1635
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
JBL type:
Center J/B
13
3A
4
3C
V
20
IK3
L-Y
2
IL1
LG
L-B
9
3I
10
3K
GR
L-B
Radio Receiver Assy
11
R4 ACC
1
R4 B
Engine Room J/B
4
2C
RAD No.1
D.C.C
1
2I
W
I15
Ignition SW
Instrument Panel J/B
3
1K
RAD No.2
6
1C
AM1
1
1A
B
1
2
1C
L
BR
3
ACC
AM1
2
20
R4 GND
W
2
F7
Fusible Link Block
ALT
2
3
W
1
FL MAIN
IB
Battery
I39184
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1825
05-1636
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK TYPE
HINT:
If the radio receiver assy is JBL type, ”JBL” is indicated on its surface.
(a) Choose type to be inspected.
Type
Go to step
Standard type
A
JBL type
B
B
Go to step 3
A
2
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY(BU+B, ACC+B, GND)
(a)
(b)
R3
ACC+B
(c)
BU+B
GND
I39174
Disconnect the connectors from the radio receiver assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Measure the voltage according to the values in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BU+B - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC+B - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1826
05-1637
DIAGNOSTICS
3
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY(B, ACC, GND)
(a)
(b)
R4
B
(c)
GND
-
ACC
I39175
Disconnect the connectors from the radio receiver assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Measure the voltage according to the values in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1827
05-1675
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRT-01
RADIO BROADCAST CANNOT BE RECEIVED(BAD RECEPTION)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK IF RADIO AUTO-SEARCH FUNCTIONS PROPERLY
Check if the radio auto-search functions properly.
(1) Perform the auto-search of the radio and check that it functions normally.
OK: The radio auto-search functions properly.
OK
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
NG
2
(a)
CHECK OPTIONAL COMPONENT
Check optional component (sun shade film, telephone antenna etc.).
(1) Check whether or not any optional component such as the sun shade film and the telephone
antenna is installed.
OK: Optional component is installed.
OK
EFFECT FROM OPTIONAL COMPONENT
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1865
05-1676
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY(ANTENNA)
(a)
Preparation for Check
(1) Remove the antenna plug of the radio receiver assembly.
Noise Check
(1) With the radio receiver assy connector connected,
turn the ignition switch to the ACC position.
(2) Turn on the radio and choose the AM mode.
(3) Place a flat-head screwdriver or a piece of metal
such as thin wire on an antenna jack of the radio receiver assy and check that the noise is heard from
the speaker.
OK: Noise occurs.
(b)
E50367
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
4
(a)
CHECK ANTENNA TYPE
Choose type to be inspected.
Type
Go to step
Glass printed type antenna
A
Fender type antenna
B
B
Go to step 7
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1866
05-1677
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
CHECK ANTENNA ASSY
Tester Probe
Tin Foil
Antenna Wire
BE4029
(a) Check for continuity of the antenna.
HINT:
Inspect the continuity, at the center of each antenna wire, as
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
When cleaning the glass, use a soft dry cloth, and wipe the
glass in the direction of the wire. Take care not to damage
the wires. Do not use detergents or glass cleaners with
abrasive ingredients. When measuring voltage, wind a
piece of tin foil around the top of the negative probe and
press the foil against the wire with your finger, as shown in
the illustration.
OK: There is continuity in the antenna.
NG
REPAIR ANTENNA ASSY (SEE PAGE 67-33 )
E32576
OK
6
(a)
REPLACE AMPLIFIER ANTENNA ASSY (SEE PAGE 67-15 OR 67-16 )
Replace the amplifier antenna assy and check if it operates normally.
OK: The amplifier antenna assy operates normally.
OK
NORMAL OPERATION
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY (SEE PAGE 67-6 )
7
(a)
CHECK ANTENNA ASSY
Check that the antenna is securely installed.
OK: The antenna is installed properly.
OK
Go to step 6
NG
INSTALL THE ANTENNA ASSY PROPERLY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1867
05-1641
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRL-02
POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT(MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER
SUB-ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides the power to the multi-display controller sub-assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
J17
J/C
Engine Room R/B
CRT
W
(*1)
1
16
IK2
V
(*1)
2
2
2
V
(*1) A
Passenger Side J/B
2
4E
8
4D
G
B
A
A
1
1H
RAD No.2
1
1A
AM1
1
F7
Fusible Link Block
Y
(*1)
2
1C
6
1C
I15
Ignition SW
L
3 ACC
AM1
2
W
2
W-B
2
ALT
C
W
1
3
16
R29 +B1
32
R29 ACC
G
(*1)
Instrument Panel J/B
Y
21
IO2
V
A (*1)
J18
J/C
14
IO1
W
Multi-display
Controller Sub-assy
J18
J/C
C
W-B
7
R31 SELD
29
R29 GND
C
W-B
FL MAIN
BF
Battery
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
I37210
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1831
05-1642
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY(+B1, ACC, GND, SELD)
R29
(a)
R31
(b)
+B1
ACC GND
SELD
I37211
(c)
Disconnect the connectors from the multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SELD - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
+B1 - GND
Always
10 - 14 V
ACC - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 - 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE PAGE
05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1832
05-1681
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
055LZ-10
SOUND QUALITY IS BAD ONLY WHEN CD IS PLAYED (VOLUME IS
TOO LOW)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
REPLACE CD WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
Replace the CD with another one and recheck.
(1) Check the installation condition of the radio receiver assembly.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
CD FAULTY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1871
05-1686
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
055LU-12
SOUND QUALITY IS BAD ONLY WHEN PLAYING TAPE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
REPLACE CASSETTE TAPE WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
Replace the cassette tape with another one and recheck.
(1) Replace the cassette tape with another normal one to see if the same trouble occurs again.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
OK
CASSETTE TAPE FAULTY
NG
2
(a)
CHECK FOR ANY FOREIGN OBJECT
Check for foreign objects.
(1) Check that no foreign objects or defects are detected in the cassette tape player.
OK: No foreign objects or defects are detected.
NG
REMOVE FOREIGN OBJECT
OK
3
CLEAN HEAD AND CHECK OPERATION
(a)
Head
Pinch Roller
Capstan
Head cleaning
(1) Raise the cassette door with your finger. Using a
pencil or similar object, push in the guide.
(2) Using a cleaning pen or cotton applicator soaked in
cleaner, clean the head surface, pinch rollers and
capstans.
(3) Check if the same trouble occurs again.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
N17398
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
HEAD DIRTY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1876
05-1673
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05CL8-04
SOUND QUALITY IS BAD IN ALL MODES (VOLUME IS TOO LOW)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
ADJUST SOUND QUALITY
Adjust the sound quality.
(1) Operate the radio receiver assy to adjust the sound quality.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
OK
BAD SOUND QUALITY
NG
2
(a)
COMPARE IT WITH ANOTHER VEHICLE OF SAME MODEL
Compare it with another vehicle of the same model.
(1) Compare it with the vehicle of the same type which does not have a trouble to see if there is any
difference in the sound quality.
OK: No difference is found.
OK
SETTING
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1863
05-1685
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05ASK-06
CASSETTE TAPE CANNOT BE EJECTED
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
PRESS ”EJECT” AND CHECK OPERATION
Press ”EJECT” and check the operation.
(1) Press the cassette tape EJECT switch of the radio receiver assembly for 2 seconds or more and
check that the cassette tape is ejected.
OK: The cassette tape is ejected.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
2
(a)
CHECK CASSETTE TAPE
Check the cassette tape.
(1) Check that the ejected cassette tape does not have a peeled label, a cassette body deformation
or any other defects.
OK: No fault on the cassette tape.
NG
CASSETTE TAPE FAULTY
OK
3
(a)
REPLACE CASSETTE TAPE WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
Replace the cassette tape with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the cassette tape with another normal one to see if the same trouble occurs again.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
CASSETTE TAPE FAULTY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1875
05-1684
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05ASJ-06
CASSETTE TAPE CANNOT BE INSERTED OR PLAYED
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK FOR ANY FOREIGN OBJECT
Check for any foreign objects.
(1) Check that no foreign objects or defects are detected in the cassette tape player of the radio receiver assembly.
OK: No foreign objects or defects are detected.
NG
REMOVE FOREIGN OBJECT
OK
2
(a)
CHECK CASSETTE TAPE
Check the cassette tape.
(1) Check that the cassette tape is a normal tape with music or voice recorded.
OK: Proper cassette tape with music or voice recorded.
NG
CASSETTE TAPE FAULTY
OK
3
(a)
REPLACE CASSETTE TAPE WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK
Replace the cassette tape with another one and recheck.
(1) Replace the cassette tape with another normal one to see if the same trouble occurs again.
OK: The function returns to be normal.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
CASSETTE TAPE FAULTY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1874
05-1687
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
055LV-12
TAPE IS TANGLED DUE TO INCORRECT TAPE SPEED OR
AUTO-REVERSE MALFUNCTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK FOR ANY FOREIGN OBJECT
Check for any foreign objects.
(1) Check that no foreign objects or defects are detected in the cassette tape player of the radio receiver assy.
OK: No foreign objects or defects are detected.
NG
REMOVE FOREIGN OBJECT
OK
2
(a)
REPLACE CASSETTE TAPE WITH ANOTHER AND RECHECK(BELOW 90 MIN.)
Replace the cassette tape with another one and recheck.
(1) Replace the cassette tape with another normal one (90 minutes. or less) to see if the same
trouble occurs again.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
OK
CASSETTE TAPE FAULTY
NG
3
CLEAN HEAD AND CHECK OPERATION
(a)
Head
Pinch Roller
Capstan
Head cleaning
(1) Raise the cassette door with your finger. Using a
pencil or similar object, push in the guide.
(2) Using a cleaning pen or cotton applicator soaked in
cleaner, clean the head surface, pinch rollers and
capstans.
(3) Check if the same trouble occurs again.
OK: Malfunction disappears.
NG
N17398
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
HEAD DIRTY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1877
05-1617
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
0569B-11
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
AUDIO SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
VIN
Production Date
Customer’s Name
Licence Plate No.
Date of Vehicle
Brought in
/
/
/
Date of First Occurrence
Frequency of Problem Occurrence
km
mile
Odometer Reading
Constant
/
Intermittent (
Times a day)
Problem
Symptom
Switch
Radio
CD
Noise
Parts name
DTC (2nd time)
DTC (1st time)
DTC
Check
Radio receiver assy
Stereo component amplifier assy
Others
I32867
I35110
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1807
05-161 1
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRH-01
DESCRIPTION
1.
RADIO WAVE BAND
The radio wave bands used in radio broadcasting are as follows:
Frequency
30 kHz
Designation
300 kHz
3 MHz
LF
MF
Modulation
300 MHz
HF
AM
Radio wave
30 MHz
VHF
FM
Amplitude modulation
Frequency modulation
LF: Low Frequency
MF: Medium Frequency
HF: High Frequency
VHF: Very High Frequency
2.
(a)
FM (Stereo)
FM (Monaural)
SERVICE AREA
There is a great difference in the size of the service areas
for AM and FM broadcasting. Sometimes an FM stereo
broadcast cannot be received even though AM can be received very clearly.
FM stereo has the smaller service area, it also picks up
static and other types of interference (”noise”) easily.
AM
BE2818
3.
RECEPTION PROBLEMS
HINT:
Besides the problem of static, there are other problems, such as ”phasing”, ”multipath” and ”fade out”. These
problems are caused not by electrical noise but by the nature of the radio waves themselves.
Phasing
(a)
Ionosphere
Phasing
Besides electrical interference, AM broadcasts are also
susceptible to other types of interference, especially at
night. This is because AM radio waves bounce off the ionosphere at night. These radio waves then interfere with
the signals that reach the vehicle’s antenna directly from
the same transmitter. This type of interference is called
”phasing”.
BE2819
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1801
05-1612
DIAGNOSTICS
Multipath
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
(b)
Multipath
Interference caused by reflection of radio waves against
obstructions is called ”Multipath”. Multipath occurs when
radio signals emitted from the broadcast transmitter antenna are reflected against tall buildings or mountains
and interferes with other signals which are to be received
directly.
(c)
Fade Out
FM radio wave tends to be reflected against obstructions
such as tall buildings or mountains because FM frequency is higher than that of AM. For this reason, FM signals
often seem to gradually disappear or fade away as the vehicle goes behind those obstructions. This phenomenon
is called ”fade out”.
BE2820
Fade Out
BE2821
4.
(a)
NOISE PROBLEMS
It is very important for technicians to understand a customer’s claim about noise clearly. Use the following table to diagnose the phenomena.
Radio wave
AM
FM
Condition in which noise occurs
Probable cause
Noise occurs at a specific place.
Strong possibility of foreign noise.
Noise occurs when listening to faint broadcasting.
The same program may be broadcasted from some local stations. If the program is the same, one of those may be tuned
in.
Noise occurs only at night.
Strong possibility of beat from a distant broadcasting.
Noise occurs at a specific place during driving.
Strong possibility of multipath noise and phasing noise caused
by changes of FM frequency.
HINT:
If the condition when the noise occurs does not meet any of the above, find out the cause based on ”Reception Problems”. Refer to the description about Multipath and Phasing mentioned previously.
5.
COMPACT DISC PLAYER
(a) Compact Disc (hereafter called ”CD”) Players use a laser beam pick-up to read the digital signals recorded on the CD and reproduce analog signals of the music, etc. 4.7 in. (12 cm) and 3.2 in. (8 cm)
discs are available for the CD player.
HINT:
Never disassemble or apply oil to any part of the player unit. Do not insert any object other than a disc, into
the CD player.
NOTICE:
CD players use an invisible laser beam which could cause hazardous radiation exposure. Be sure
to operate the player correctly as instructed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1802
05-1613
DIAGNOSTICS
6.
Example:
Head
Capstan
(a)
(b)
Pinch Roller
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
MAINTENANCE
Tape Player/Head Cleaning:
Raise the cassette door with your finger.
Using a pencil or similar object, push in the guide.
Using a cleaning pen or cotton applicator soaked in cleaner, clean the head surface, pinch rollers and capstans.
N17398
7.
MAINTENANCE
CD Player/Disc Cleaning:
If the disc gets dirty, clean the disc by wiping the surface from
the center to outside in the radial directions with a soft cloth.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or anti-static preservative.
BE4331
8.
(a)
AVC-LAN Description
What is AVC-LAN?
AVC-LAN, an abbreviation for ”Audio Visual Communication Local Area Network”, is a united standard
developed by the manufacturers in affiliation with Toyota Motor Corporation. This standard pertains
to audio and visual signals as well as switch and communication signals.
Example:
Radio Receiver Assy
(Resister 60 to 80 Ω)
AVC-LAN
Multi-display
controller
Sub-assy
I39082
(b)
Purpose:
Recently, car audio systems have rapidly developed and the functions vastly changed. The conventional car audio system is being integrated with multi-media interfaces similar to those in navigation
systems. At the same time, customers are demanding higher quality from their audio systems. This
is merely an overview of the standardization background. The specific purposes are as follows.
(1) To solve sound problems, etc. caused by using components of different manufacturers through
signal standardization.
(2) To allow each manufacturer to concentrate on developing products they do best. From this, reasonably priced products can be produced.
HINT:
If a +B or GND short is detected in the AVC-LAN circuit, communication is interrupted and the audio
system will stop functioning.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1803
05-1614
DIAGNOSTICS
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
10.
(a)
(b)
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
If an audio system is equipped with a navigation system, the multi-display unit acts as the master unit.
If the navigation system is not equipped, the audio head unit acts as the master unit instead. If the radio
and navigation assy is equipped, it is the master unit.
The radio receiver assy provides resistance to make communication possible.
The car audio system with an AVC-LAN circuit has a diagnostic function.
Each component has a specified number (3-digit) called a physical address. Each function has a number (2-digit) called a logical address.
Communication system outline
Components of the audio system communicate with each other via the AVC-LAN.
Radio receiver assy has enough resistance (60 to 80 Ω) necessary for transmitting the communication.
This is essential for communication.
If a short circuit or open circuit occurs in the AVC-LAN circuit, communication is interrupted and the
audio system will stop functioning.
Diagnostic function outline
The audio system has a diagnostic function (the result is indicated on the master unit).
A 3-digit hexadecimal component code (physical address) is allocated to each component on the
AVC-LAN. Using this code, the component in the diagnostic function can be displayed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1804
05-1624
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
055LJ-12
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Terms
Meaning
Three-digit code (shown in hexadecimal) which is given to each component comprising the AVC-LAN.
Corresponding to the function, individual symbols are specified.
Physical address
Logical address
Two-digit code (shown in hexadecimal) which is given to each function comprising
the inner system of the AVC-LAN.
HINT:
Titles for each unit are stated in the following order: physical address(parts name).
1.
190 (RADIO RECEIVER ASSY)
HINT:
*1: Even if no failure is detected, trouble codes may be stored depending on the battery condition or
voltage for starting the engine.
*2: The code is stored 180 seconds after the power supply connector is disconnected after engine
start.
*3: The code may be stored when the engine key is turned 1 minute after engine start.
*4: The code may be stored when the engine key is turned again after engine start.
(a) Logical address: 01 (Communication control)
DTC
Diagnosis item
Diagnosis content
Countermeasure and inspected parts
21
ROM Error
Abnormal condition of ROM is detected.
Replace radio receiver assy.
22
RAM Error
Abnormal condition of RAM is detected.
Replace radio receiver assy.
Absence of Master
Component in which this code is recorded
was disconnected from system or master
component with ignition switch in ACC or
ON.
Check harness for power supply system of
radio receiver assy.
Check harness for communication system
of radio receiver assy.
No Response to Connection Check
Component shown by sub code is or was
disconnected from system after engine
start.
Check harness for power supply system of
component shown by sub code.
Check harness for communication system
of component shown by sub code.
Last Mode Error
Audio or visual component operated before
engine stop is or was disconnected with
ignition switch in ACC or ON.
Check harness for power supply system of
component shown by sub code.
Check harness for communication system
of component shown by sub code.
No Response to ON/OFF Instruction
No response is identified when changing
mode (audio and visual mode change).
Sound and picture does not change by button operation.
Check harness for power supply system of
component shown by sub code.
Check harness for communication system
of component shown by sub code.
If error occurs again, replace component
shown by sub code.
Mode Status Error
Dual alarm is detected.
Check harness for power supply system of
component shown by sub code.
Check harness for communication system
of component shown by sub code.
D6
*1
D8
*2
D9
*1
DA
DB
*1
DC
*3
DD
*4
Transmission Error
Master Reset (Momentary Interruption)
Transmission to component shown by auxiliary code has been failed.
(Detecting this DTC does not necessarily
mean actual failure.)
After the engine was started, master component was disconnected from system.
If same sub code is recorded in other component, check harness for power supply and
communication system of all components
shown by code.
(If not, delete DTC and recheck.)
Check harness for power supply system of
radio receiver assy.
Check harness for communication system
of radio receiver assy.
If this error occurs frequently, replace radio
receiver assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1814
05-1625
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
Diagnosis item
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
Diagnosis content
Countermeasure and inspected parts
Check harness for power supply of component shown by sub code.
Check harness for communication system
of component shown by sub code.
DE
*4
Slave Reset (Momentary Interruption)
After the engine was started, component
shown by sub code was disconnected from
system.
DF
*4
Master Error
Due to defective cognition of component
with a display, master function is switched to
audio equipment.
Error occurs in communication between
sub-master (audio) and master component.
E0
*1
Registration Completion Instruction Error
”Registration Completion Instruction” command from master cannot be received.
Since this DTC is provided for engineering
purposes, it may be detected when no actual failure exists.
Voice Processing Device ON Error
When the AMP device records that the AMP
output does not function even while the
source device operates.
Check harness for power supply of radio
receiver assy.
Check harness for communication system
of radio receiver assy.
ON/OFF Instruction Parameter Error
Error occurs in ON/OFF controlling command from master component.
E1
*1
E2
(b)
Replace radio receiver assy.
Registration Request Transmission
Registration Request command is output
from component shown by sub code.
Receiving Connection Check Instruction,
Registration Request command is output
from sub-master component.
Since this DTC is provided for engineering
purposes, it may be detected when no actual failure exists.
Multiple Frame Abort
Multiple frame transmission is aborted.
Since this DTC is provided for engineering
purposes, it may be detected when no actual failure exists.
E3
*1
E4
*1
Check harness for power supply of radio
receiver assy.
Check harness for communication system
of radio receiver assy.
Check harness for communication system
between radio receiver assy and sub-master component.
Logical address: 60 (Radio unit)
DTC
Diagnosis item
Diagnosis content
Countermeasure and inspected parts
43
AM Tuner Error
Abnormal condition of AM tuner is detected.
Replace radio receiver assy.
44
FM Tuner Error
Abnormal condition of FM tuner is detected.
Replace radio receiver assy.
(c)
Logical address: 61 (Cassette unit)
DTC
Diagnosis item
Diagnosis content
Countermeasure and inspected parts
Malfunction due to mechanical failure is
identified.
Either that, or cassette tape is cut or entangled.
Inspect cassette tape.
Replace radio receiver assy.
40
Mechanical Error of Media
41
EJECT Error
Malfunction due to mechanical failure.
Replace radio receiver assy.
42
Tape caught in the radio receiver assy
Hub lock etc.
Inspect cassette tape.
(d)
DTC
Logical address: 62 (CD player)
Diagnosis item
47
Detection of high temperature
48
Detection of excess current
(e)
DTC
Diagnosis content
Countermeasure and inspected parts
High temperature is detected in CD player.
With ignition switch off, leave vehicle in cool
shaded place for a while and recheck. After
deleting the DTC memory, if same code detected, replace radio receiver assy.
Excess current flows into CD player.
Replace radio receiver assy.
Logical address: 63 (In-dash CD changer)
Diagnosis item
Diagnosis content
Countermeasure and inspected parts
51
CD changer elevator error
Mechanical error occurred during elevator
operation
Replace radio receiver assy.
52
CD changer clump error
Failure in disc clamping or clamp error
Replace radio receiver assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1815
05-1626
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
2.
1F6,16C,16D (MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY)
HINT:
*1: Even if no failure is detected, this code may be stored depending on the battery condition or voltage
for starting the engine.
*2: The code is stored 180 seconds after the power supply connector is disconnected after engine
start.
*3: The code may be stored when the engine key is turned 1 minute after engine start.
*4: The code may be stored when the engine key is turned again after engine start.
*5: If the device is reported as not existing during verification, check the power source circuit and AVCLAN circuit for the device.
(a) Logical address: 01 (Communication control)
DTC
Diagnosis item
Condition
Countermeasure and inspected parts
Absence of Master
Component in which this code is recorded
was disconnected from system with ignition
switch in ACC or ON. Either that, or multidisplay controller sub-assy was disconnected when this code was recorded.
Check harness for power supply system of
radio receiver assy.
Check harness for communication system
of radio receiver assy.
Check harness for communication system
between radio receiver assy and multi-display controller sub-assy.
D7
*2
Connection Check Error
Component in which this code is recorded
was disconnected from system after engine
start. Either that, or multi-display controller
sub-assy was disconnected when this code
was recorded.
Check harness for power supply system of
radio receiver assy.
Check harness for communication system
of radio receiver assy.
Check harness for power supply of multidisplay controller sub-assy.
Check harness for communication system
of multi-display controller sub-assy.
DC
*2
*5
Transmission Error
Transmission to component shown by subcode failed.
(This code does not necessarily mean actual failure.)
If same sub-code is recorded in other component(s), check harness for power supply
and communication system of all components shown by code.
DD
*3
Master Reset (Momentary Interruption)
Master component was disconnected after
engine start.
Check harness for power supply system of
radio receiver assy.
Check harness for communication system
of radio receiver assy.
Check harness for power supply of multidisplay controller sub-assy.
Check harness for communication system
of multi-display controller sub-assy.
If error occurs frequently, replace radio receiver assy.
DF
*4
Master Error
Due to defective condition of component
with a display, master function is switched to
audio equipment.
Error occurs in communication between
sub-master (audio) and master component.
Check harness for power supply of radio
receiver assy.
Check harness for communication system
of radio receiver assy.
Check harness for communication system
between multi-display controller sub-assy
and radio receiver assy.
E0
*1
Registration Completion Instruction Error
”Registration Completion Instruction” command from master cannot be received.
Since this DTC is provided for engineering,
it may be detected when no actual failure
exists.
E2
ON/OFF Instruction Parameter Error
Error occurs in ON/OFF controlling command from radio receiver assy.
D6
*1
Replace radio receiver assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1816
05-1627
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
Diagnosis item
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
Condition
Countermeasure and inspected parts
E3
*1
Registration Request Transmission
Registration Request command is output
from slave component.
Registration Request command is output
from sub-master component.
Since this DTC is provided for engineering,
it may be detected when no actual failure
exists.
E4
Multiple Frame Abort
Multiple frame transmission is aborted.
Since this DTC is provided for engineering
purpose, it may be detected when no actual
failure exists.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1817
05-1615
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
055LG-12
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS (SEE PAGE 05-1617 )
3
BASIC INSPECTION
(a)
Basic inspection.
(1) Check the battery voltage.
Standard: 11 to 14 V
Check the power supply to the radio receiver assy.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position.
(2) Check whether or not the display appears on the radio receiver assy.
(b)
DISPLAY DOES NOT APPEAR (PROCEED TO
PROBLEM SYMPTOM TABLE) (SEE PAGE
05-1632 )
DISPLAY APPEARS (GO TO STEP 4)
4
DTC CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1618 )
HINT:
If the audio system is equipped with a multi-display, check DTCs in the NAVIGATION SYSTEM section(see
page 05-1757 ).
DTC IS OUTPUT (GO TO STEP 9)
DTC IS NOT OUTPUT (GO TO STEP 10)
5
DTC CHART (SEE PAGE 05-1624 )
GO TO STEP 12
6
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE PAGE 05-1632 )
7
CIRCUIT INSPECTION AND PART INSPECTION (SEE PAGE 05-1634 - 05-1688 )
8
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1805
05-1616
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
CONFIRMATION TEST
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1806
05-1628
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
055LK-11
LOCATION
Fusible Link Block
Engine Room J/B
DOME Fuse
RAD No. 1 Fuse
ALT Fuse
Steering Pad SW LH
Instrument Panel J/B
RAD No. 2 Fuse
AM1 Fuse
PANEL Fuse
TAILLIGHT Relay
Antenna Amplifier
Fix Antenna
Front No.2 Speaker
Assy RH
Radio Receiver Assy
Ignition Switch
Front No.2
Speaker Assy
LH
Front No.1 Speaker
Assy RH
Antenna Amplifier
Spiral Cable
Sub-assy
Glass Printed Antenna
(AM, FM)
Front No.1 Speaker
Assy LH
Rear Speaker
Assy LH
Glass Printed Antenna
(FM Sub Antenna)
Stereo Component Amplifier Assy *1
Rear Speaker
Assy RH
*1: JBL type
I39163
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1818
05-1618
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
055LI-10
SEEK TRACK
1
PRE-CHECK
6
1.
(a)
DISC
I40723
(b)
DIAGNOSTIC CHECK
Starting Diagnostic Mode (All elements come on during
the SW check mode.)
(1) Turn off the audio system and turn the ignition
switch to the ACC position. While pressing the preset switches ”1” and ”6” at the same time, press the
”DISC” 3 times.
(2) Reference:
When the system enters the Diagnosis Mode,
beep sound is emitted 3 times and all the elements come on during the SW check mode.
It takes about 40 seconds to complete the
check.
Turn all the elements in the LCD on.
When pressing the switch, confirm beep
sound is emitted.
Press the ”SEEK TRACK UP” switch to enter
the ”Service Check Screen”.
Service Check Screen
(1) Reference:
In the service check mode, the system check and
the diagnostic memory check are performed, and
the check results are displayed in ascending order
of the component codes (physical address).
Terms
Meaning
Component code
(Physical address)
Three-digit code (in hexadecimal) given to each device
comprising AVC-LAN. Corresponding to its function, individual symbol is provided.
Logical address
Two-digit code (in hexadecimal) given to each function and
device unit in each device comprising AVC-LAN.
Code No. (physical address) List
Code No.
(physical address)
190
1F6, 16C
(c)
Equipment name
Radio receiver assy (Audio head unit)
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy
Finishing Diagnostic Mode
(1) Press the ”DISC” switch for 2 seconds or more, or
turn the ignition switch off.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1808
05-1619
DIAGNOSTICS
(d)
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
Service Check Mode Result Display (for checking the current and the past system conditions).
(1) Press the ”SEEK TRACK” switch to see the check
result of each component.
P---indicates physical address.
190---physical address
good---”The component is normal”.
P---indicates physical address.
360---physical address
CHEC---”Check needed”.
: SEEK TRACK UP
: SEEK TRACK DOWN
The illustration shows the case that the system has 2 components with codes 190 and 360, and one component
(code 360) requires a check.
The check result is displayed in ascending order of component code. The component device code is displayed
first, and then the check result follows.
I34696
(2)
Display
good
NCON
ECHN
CHEC
Check Result Display.
Original Language
Meaning
Action to be taken
Good (normal)
No DTCs are detected in both ”System Check Mode” and
”Diagnostic Memory Mode”.
-
No connection
The system recognized the component when it was registered, but the component gives no response to the ”Diagnostic Mode ON Request”.
Check the power source circuit and the communication
circuit of the component indicated by the component
code (physical address).
Exchange
One or more DTCs for ”Exchange” are detected in either
”System Check Mode” or ”Diagnostic Memory Mode”.
Go to the detailed information mode to check the
trouble area referring to the
DTC list.
Check
When no DTCs are detected for ”Exchange”, one or more
DTCs for ”Check” are detected in either ”System Check
Mode” or ”Diagnostic Memory Mode”.
Go to the detailed information mode to check the
trouble area referring to the
DTC list.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1809
05-1620
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
Display
Original Language
Meaning
Action to be taken
OLD
Old version
Old DTC application is identified and DTC is detected in either ”System Check Mode” or ”Diagnostic Memory Mode”.
-
No response
The device gives no response to any one of ”System Check
Mode ON Request”, ”System Check Result Request” and
”Diagnostic Memory Request”.
Check the power source circuit and the communication
circuit of the component indicated by the component
code (physical address).
NRES
(3)
(e)
To perform the Service Check again, press the preset switch ”1”.
Detailed Information Mode (when displaying the DTC for
a trouble component)
(1) With ”CHEC” or ”ECHN” being displayed, press the
preset switch ”2” to go to the detailed information
mode.
(2) Press the ”SEEK TRACK” switch to display the
”System Check Result (SYS)” and ”Diagnostic
Memory Response (CODE)”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1810
05-1621
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
Service Check Mode
PRESET SWITCH ”3”
Detailed Information Mode
PRESET SWITCH ”2”
P---indicates physical address.
190---physical address
*1
SYS---system check result
1---the first code
62---logical address
Detailed information
of the first code
is displayed.
47---DTC
Continue to display detailed information
when more than one DTC are detected.
CODE---diagnosis memory
response result
2---the second code
01---logical address
DC---DTC
P---indicates physical address.
360---sub code
Detail information
of the second code
is displayed.
(*2)
6F---connection
check number
05---the number of times of
occurrence
(in decimal)
Continue to display detailed information
when more than one DTC are detected.
: SEEK TRACK UP
: SEEK TRACK DOWN
From *1
To *1
The illustration shows the case that the component with code 190 has DTC ”47” and ”dC” as a result of the
system check and the diagnostic memory response.
The detailed information mode shows the system check result first, then the diagnostic memory response result
follows. (*2): As for the DTCs that do not have any sub code, sub code is not displayed.
I34695
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1811
05-1622
DIAGNOSTICS
(3)
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
Displayed Items in Detailed Information Mode
Division Code for
DTC display
Meaning
The order of detailed information displayed when the ”TUNE
UP” switch is pressed (The order is reversed when the ”TUNE
DOWN” switch is pressed.)
SYS
System check result is displayed.
Logical address →
DTC
Diagnostic memory check result is displayed.
Logical address→
DTC→
Sub code→
Connection confirmation number→
The number of times of occurrence
CODE
(4)
(5)
(f)
Check the trouble area referring to the DTC list.
To return to the service check mode, press the preset switch ”3”.
Clearing Individual DTC Memory (when clearing the
memory of the DTC detected in the past individually)
(1) Press the preset switch ”5” for 2 seconds or more
while the ”ECHN” is displayed in the service check
mode or during the detailed information mode.
HINT:
(g)
A beep sound is emitted once when the DTC memory is
completely cleared.
When the DTC memory is cleared, only the component
code (physical address) is displayed for the target component.
To check DTCs, press the preset switch ”1” and perform
the service check again.
Clearance of all the DTC memory (when clearing all the
memory of the DTCs detected in the past)
(1) Start the diagnostic mode after repairing the trouble
area.
(2) Press the preset switch ”5” for 2 seconds or more.
(”CLR” is displayed at this time.)
HINT:
A beep sound is emitted once when the DTC memory is
completely cleared.
When the DTC memory for all the component is cleared,
only the component codes (physical address) are displayed.
(3) Press the preset switch ”1” to perform the service
check again, and check that no DTCs are displayed
for all the component codes (physical address).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1812
05-1623
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
IDENTIFICATION OF NOISE SOURCE
Identify the condition in which the noise occurs, and
check the noise filter on the related part.
Condition in which noise occurs
Noise Source
Depressing the acceleration pedal increases the noise, and stopping the
engine stops the noise immediately.
Generator
Noise occurs during A/C or the heater operation.
Blower motor
Rapid acceleration while driving on an unpaved road or after the ignition
switch is turned on makes noise.
Fuel pump
Pressing and then releasing the horn switch, and keeping pressing the horn
switch makes unusual noise.
Horn
Quiet noise is heard while the engine is running, but stops with the engine.
Ignition
Noise occurs synchronously with the turn signal flash.
Flasher
Noise occurs during the window washer operation.
Washer
Noise occurs during the engine running, and it continues even after the engine stops.
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Noise occurs during the wiper operation.
Wiper
Noise occurs when the brake pedal is depressed.
Stop light switch
Others
Static electricity stored on the vehicle
(b)
Reference:
Make sure first that there is no noise from outside.
Failing to do so makes the noise source detection
difficult and leads to misunderstanding.
The noise should be removed in descending order
of loudness.
Turning the radio so that no station is received
makes the noise more noticeable, making the recognition of the phenomenon easier.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1813
05-1632
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
055LM-12
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Pressing power switch does not start system.
5. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
6. Radio receiver assy
05-1634
67-6
All switches do not respond.
1. Steering pad switch circuit
2. Radio receiver assy
05-1643
67-6
Turning on light switch does not light up night time illumination of
radio receiver.
1. Illumination circuit
2. Radio receiver assy
05-1647
67-6
05-1634
05-1638
All sound can not be heard.
1. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
2. Power source circuit (stereo component
amplifier assy) *1
3. AMP sound signal circuit (radio receiver
assy - AMP) *1
4. Speaker circuit
5. AMP mute signal circuit (from radio receiver assy) *1
6. Stereo component amplifier assy *1
7. Radio receiver assy
1. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
2. Power source circuit (stereo component
amplifier assy) *1
3. Speaker circuit (driver side speaker) *2
4. AMP sound signal circuit (radio receiver
assy - AMP) *1
5. Stereo component amplifier assy *1
6. Radio receiver assy
05-1634
05-1638
1. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
2. Power source circuit (stereo component
amplifier assy) *1
3. Speaker circuit
4. AMP sound signal circuit (radio receiver
assy - AMP) *1
5. Sound quality is bad in all modes (volume is too low)
6. Stereo component amplifier assy *1
7. Radio receiver assy
05-1634
05-1638
Front speaker (driver side) only is not heard. (volume is too low)
Sound quality is bad in all modes. (volume is too low)
Sound quality is bad or sound is not heard. (RSE sound)
05-1669
05-1657
05-1651
67-20
67-6
05-1664
05-1669
67-20
67-6
1. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
2. Power source circuit (multi-display
controller sub-assy)
3. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy radio receiver assy)
4. RSE sound signal circuit (multi-display controller subassy - radio receiver assy)
5. Mute signal circuit (from multi-display controller subassy)
6. Radio receiver assy
7. Multi-display controller sub-assy
05-1657
05-1669
05-1673
67-20
67-6
05-1634
05-1641
05-1688
05-1671
05-1654
67-6
67-23
Noise occurs.
-
05-1674
Radio broadcast cannot be received. (bad reception)
-
05-1675
CD cannot be inserted or is ejected right after insertion.
1. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
2. CD cannot be inserted or is ejected right after insertion
05-1634
05-1678
CD cannot be ejected.
1. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
2. CD cannot be ejected
05-1634
05-1680
Sound quality is bad only when playing CD. (volume is too low)
-
05-1681
CD sound skips.
-
05-1682
Cassette tape cannot be inserted or played.
1. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
2. Cassette tape cannot be inserted or played
05-1634
05-1684
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1822
05-1633
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
Cassette tape cannot be ejected.
1. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
2. Cassette tape cannot be ejected
05-1634
05-1685
Sound quality is bad only when playing tape.
-
05-1686
Tape is tangled due to incorrect tape speed or auto-reverse malfunction.
-
05-1687
*1: JBL type
*2: w/ Navigation System
STEERING PAD SWITCH
Symptom
A audio system cannot be operated with steering pad switch
Suspect Area
See page
1. Steering pad switch circuit
2. Radio receiver assy
05-1643
67-6
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1823
05-1629
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
05IRI-01
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
RADIO RECEIVER ASSY (STANDARD TYPE)
R3
R2
I40196
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
R - BR
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
RL+ (R2-2) - GND (R3-7)
B - BR
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
RR- (R2-3) - GND (R3-7)
W - BR
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
Illumination (rheostat)
signal
Light control switch TAIL or HEAD
Sound signal (Real Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
RR+ (R2-1) - GND (R3-7)
ILL- (R2-5) - Body ground
W - Body ground
RL- (R2-6) - GND (R3-7)
Y - BR
FR+ (R3-1) - GND (R3-7)
LG - BR
FL+ (R3-2) - GND (R3-7)
P - BR
Condition
ACC+B (R3-3) - GND (R3-7)
GR - BR
Accessory (ON)
Turn Ignition switch
OFF → ACC or ON
BU+B (R3-4) - GND (R3-7)
L-B - BR
Specification
10 to 14 V
Below 1V →
10 to 14 V
Battery
Always
FR- (R3-5) - GND (R3-7)
L - BR
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
FL- (R3-6) - GND (R3-7)
V - BR
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
GND (R3-7) - Body ground
BR Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
ILL+ (R3-10) - GND (R3-7)
G - BR
Illumination (rheostat)
signal
Light control switch TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
2.
10 to 14 V
RADIO RECEIVER ASSY (JBL TYPE)
R4
R22
R23
I40207
Symbols (Terminal No.)
B (R4-1) - GND (R4-20)
Wiring Color
L-B - BR
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
Light control switch TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
ILL+ (R4-2) - GND (R4-20)
G - BR
Illumination (rheostat)
signal
AMP+ (R4-3) - GND (R4-20)
V - BR
Stereo component amplifier assy control signal
Turn Ignition switch
OFF → ACC or ON
Below 1V →
10 to 14 V
MUTE (R4-7) - GND (R4-20)
BR - BR
MUTE signal
Audio system is sounding → changing
Above 3.5 V
→ Below 1 V
FR+ (R4-8) - GND (R4-20)
W - BR
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
FL+ (R4-9) - GND (R4-20)
B - BR
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1819
05-1630
DIAGNOSTICS
SLD (R4-10) - Body ground
Shielded Body ground
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
Below 1 Ω
Shield ground
Always
Accessory
Turn Ignition switch
OFF → ACC or ON
Below 1V →
10 to 14 V
ACC (R4-11) - GND (R4-20)
GR - BR
ILL- (R4-12) - GND (R4-20)
W - BR
Illumination (rheostat)
signal
Light control switch TAIL or HEAD
ANT+ (R4-13) - GND (R4-20)
O - BR
Power source of antenna
See ”Service Check Mode”
S.GND (R4-16) - Body ground
Y - Body ground
Shield ground
Always
BEEP (R4-17) - GND (R4-20)
L - BR
Beep sound signal
Audio system is sounding
-
RR+ (R4-18) - GND (R4-20)
G - BR
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
RL+ (R4-19) - GND (R4-20)
R - BR
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
GND (R4-20) - Body ground
BR Body ground
Ground
Always
10 to 14 V
Below 1 Ω
Below 1 Ω
R+ (R22-2) - GND (R4-20)
B - BR
Sound signal (Right)
RSE system is sounding
-
R- (R22-3) - GND (R4-20)
W - BR
Sound signal (Right)
RSE system is sounding
-
L+ (R22-4) - GND (R4-20)
R - BR
Sound signal (Left)
RSE system is sounding
-
L- (R22-5) - GND (R4-20)
G - BR
Sound signal (Left)
RSE system is sounding
-
MUTE (R22-6) - GND (R4-20)
P - BR
MUTE signal
RSE system is sounding → changing
TX1+ (R23-9) - GND (R4-20)
Y - BR
AVC - LAN
communication signal
Turn Ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
TX1- (R23-10) - GND (R4-20)
L - BR
AVC - LAN
communication signal
Turn Ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
3.
Above 3.5 V
→ Below 1 V
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER ASSY (JBL TYPE)
S23
S22
I30200
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
AMP+ (S22-1) GND (S23-12)
P - W-B
Stereo component amplifier assy control signal
Radio switch is ON
10 to 14 V
ACC (S22-2) - GND (S23-12)
G - W-B
Accessory (ON)
Turn Ignition switch
OFF → ACC or ON
Below 1V →
10 to 14 V
BEEP (S22-4) GND (S23-12)
L - W-B
Beep sound signal
Audio system is sounding
-
F.L (S22-5) - GND (S23-12)
B - W-B
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
F.R (S22-6) - GND (S23-12)
W - W-B
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is sounding
Y - Body ground
Shield ground
Always
BR - W-B
MUTE signal
Audio system is sounding → changing
SGND (S22-11) - Body ground
MUTE (S22-12) GND (S23-12)
Condition
Specification
Below 1 Ω
Above 3.5 V
→ Below 1 V
R.L (S22-13) - GND (S23-12)
R - W-B
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
R.R (S22-14) - GND (S23-12)
G - W-B
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
FR+ (S23-1) - GND (S23-12)
LG - W-B
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
FL+ (S23-2) - GND (S23-12)
Y - W-B
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
RR+ (S23-3) - GND (S23-12)
R - W-B
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
RL+ (S23-4) - GND (S23-12)
GR - W-B
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is sounding
+B (S23-7) - GND (S23-12)
R-Y - W-B
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1820
05-1631
DIAGNOSTICS
FR- (S23-8) - GND (S23-12)
L - W-B
FL- (S23-9) - GND (S23-12)
-
AUDIO SYSTEM
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
R-Y - W-B
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
RR- (S23-10) - GND (S23-12)
G - W-B
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
RL- (S23-11) - GND (S23-12)
LG - W-B
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
GND (S23-12) - Body ground
W-B Body ground
Ground
Always
4.
Below 1 Ω
MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY
R31
R29
I40208
Symbols (Terminal No.)
L- (R29-7) - GND (R29-29)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
G - W-B
Sound signal (Left)
RSE system is sounding
-
L+ (R29-8) - GND (R29-29)
R - W-B
Sound signal (Left)
RSE system is sounding
-
R- (R29-9) - GND (R29-29)
W - W-B
Sound signal (Right)
RSE system is sounding
-
R+ (R29-10) - GND (R29-29)
B - W-B
Sound signal (Right)
RSE system is sounding
-
SG1 (R29-11) - Body ground
Shielded Body ground
Shield ground
Always
LMUT (R29-12) - GND
(R29-29)
V - W-B
MUTE signal
RSE system is sounding → changing
+B1 (R29-16) - GND (R29-29)
Y - W-B
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
GND (R29-29) - Body ground
W-B Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Below 1 Ω
Above 3.5 V
→ Below 1 V
TX- (R29-30) - GND (R29-29)
GR - W-B
AVC - LAN
communication signal
Turn Ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
TX+ (R29-31) - GND (R29-29)
LG - W-B
AVC - LAN
communication signal
Turn Ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
ACC (R29-32) - GND
(R29-29)
G - W-B
Accessory (ON)
Turn Ignition switch
OFF → ACC or ON
Ground
Always
SELD (R31-7) - Body ground
W-B Body ground
Below 1V →
10 to 14 V
Below 1 Ω
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1821
05-1 130
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05ITS-01
B1411/11 ROOM TEMPERATURE SENSOR CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the temperature inside the cabin and sends the appropriate signals to the A/C amplifier
assy.
DTC No.
B1411/11
Detection item
Trouble Area
Open or short in room temperature sensor circuit
Cooler (room temperature sensor) thermistor
Harness or connector between cooler (room temperature
sensor) thermistor and A/C amplifier assy
A/C amplifier assy
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier assy
Y
3
A11
SG-3
1
R6
Cooler (Room Temperature
Sensor)Thermistor
2
4
W
A11 TR
I18376
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1320
05-1 131
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
In case of using the hand-held tester, start the inspection step 1 and in case of not using the hand-held
tester, start from step 2.
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the items below in the DATA LIST,and read the displays on the hand-held tester.
A C:
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ROOM TEMP
Room temperature sensor
/min.: -6.5C (20.3F)
max.: 57.25C (135.05F)
Actual room temperature
-
Result:
NG
A
OK (Checking from the DTC)
B
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOM TABLE)
C
B
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
C
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
A
2
INSPECT AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY(TR, SG-3)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
(b)
(c)
A11
TR (+)
SG-3 (-)
I30331
Remove A/C amplifier assy with connectors still connected.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A11-3 (SG-3) A11-4 (TR)
at 25C (77F)
1.8 to 2.2 V
A11-3 (SG-3) A11-4 (TR)
at 40C (104F)
1.2 to 1.6 V
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the voltage decreases.
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1321
05-1 132
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT COOLER (ROOM TEMP. SENSOR) THERMISTOR
(a)
(b)
Cooler Thermistor Connector
Front View:
R6
I30111
Remove cooler (room temperature sensor) thermistor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
R6-1 - R6-2
10°C (50°F)
3.00 to 3.73 kΩ
R6-1 - R6-2
15°C (59°F)
2.45 to 2.88 kΩ
R6-1 - R6-2
20°F (68°F)
1.95 to 2.30 kΩ
R6-1 - R6-2
25°C (77°F)
1.60 to 1.80 kΩ
R6-1 - R6-2
30°C (86°F)
1.28 to 1.47 kΩ
R6-1 - R6-2
35°C (95°F)
1.00 to 1.22 kΩ
R6-1 - R6-2
40°C (104°F)
0.80 to 1.00 kΩ
R6-1 - R6-2
45°C (113°F)
0.65 to 0.85 kΩ
R6-1 - R6-2
50°C (122°F)
0.50 to 0.70 kΩ
R6-1 - R6-2
55°C (131°F)
0.44 to 0.60 kΩ
R6-1 - R6-2
60°C (140°F)
0.36 to 0.50 kΩ
NOTICE:
Even slightly touching the sensor may change the resistance value. Be sure to hold the connector of the
sensor.
When measuring the sensor temperature must be the
same as the ambient temperature.
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the resistance decreases (see
the chart below).
4.0
3.5
3.0
2.5
Resistance
(kΩ)
Maximum permissible value line
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
Minimum permissible value line
0.0
0
32
20
68
40
104
Temperature
60 (°C)
140 (°F)
I38777
I40673
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1322
05-1 133
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NG
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
REPLACE COOLER (ROOM TEMP. SENSOR)
THERMISTOR
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(COOLER (ROOM TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
THERMISTOR - A/C AMPLIFIER ASSY)
(a)
Cooler (Room Temperature Sensor)
Thermistor Connector Front View:
R6
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A11-4 (TR) - R6-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-3 (SG-3) - R6-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-4 (TR) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11-3 (SG-3) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11
TR
SG-3
NG
I41011
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1323
05-1 134
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05ITT-01
B1412/12 AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM and A/C amplifier communicate via BEAN.
This sensor detects the temperature outside the cabin and sends the appropriate signals to the A/C amplifier
assy.
DTC No.
B1412/12
Detection item
Trouble Area
Cooler (ambient temperature sensor) thermistor
Harness or connector between cooler (ambient temperature
sensor) thermistor and ECM
ECM
A/C amplifier assy
Open or short in ambient temperature sensor circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
A/C Amplifier assy
2
MPX+ A11
BEAN signal
9
MPX- A10
6
EB2
BR
BR
Short Connector
5
5
S28
S29
BR
18
E6
MPX1
29
E6
MPX2
28
E7
E2
32
E6
TAM
1
A1
Cooler (Ambient Temperature
Sensor) Thermistor
2
5
IK3
B
B-R
I38775
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1324
05-1 135
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
In case of using the hand-held tester, start the inspection step 1 and in case of not using the hand-held
tester, start from step 2.
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the items below in the DATA LIST, and read the displays on the hand-held tester.
A C:
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
AMBI TEMP SENS
Ambient temperature sensor
/min.: -23.3C (-9.94F)
max.: 65.95C (150.71F)
Actual ambient temperature
-
AMBI TEMP
adjusted ambient temperature
/min.: -30.8C (-23.44F)
max.: 50.8C (123.44F)
Actual ambient temperature
-
Result:
NG
A
OK (Checking from the DTC)
B
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOM TABLE)
C
B
REPLACE ECM
C
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE(SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
A
2
INSPECT ECM(TAM, E2)
(a)
(b)
(c)
ECM Connector Wire Harness View:
E7
E6
E2 (-)
TAM (+)
I38774
Remove ECM with connectors still connected.
Turn ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
E6-32 (TAM) E7-28 (E2)
at 25C (77F)
1.4 to 1.8 V
E6-32 (TAM) E7-28 (E2)
at 40C (104F)
0.8 to 1.2 V
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the voltage decreases.
OK
REPLACE ECM
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1325
05-1 136
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT COOLER (AMBIENT TEMP. SENSOR) THERMISTOR
(a)
(b)
Ambient Temperature Sensor
Connector Front View:
A1
1
2
I30487
Remove cooler (ambient temperature sensor) thermistor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A1-1 - A1-2
10°C (50°F)
3.00 to 3.73 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
15°C (59°F)
2.45 to 2.88 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
20°F (68°F)
1.95 to 2.30 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
25°C (77°F)
1.60 to 1.80 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
30°C (86°F)
1.28 to 1.47 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
35°C (95°F)
1.00 to 1.22 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
40°C (104°F)
0.80 to 1.00 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
45°C (113°F)
0.65 to 0.85 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
50°C (122°F)
0.50 to 0.70 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
55°C (131°F)
0.44 to 0.60 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
60°C (140°F)
0.36 to 0.50 kΩ
NOTICE:
Even slightly touching the sensor may change the resistance value. Be sure to hold the connector of the
sensor.
When measuring the sensor temperature must be the
same as the ambient temperature.
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the resistance decreases (see
the chart below).
4.0
3.5
3.0
2.5
Resistance
(kΩ)
Maximum permissible value line
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
Minimum permissible value line
0.0
0
32
20
68
40
104
Temperature
60 (°C)
140 (°F)
I38777
I40673
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1326
05-1 137
DIAGNOSTICS
NG
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
REPLACE COOLER (AMBIENT TEMP. SENSOR)
THERMISTOR
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(COOLER (AMBIENT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR) THERMISTOR - ECM)
(a)
Ambient Temperature Sensor
Connector Front View:
A1
1
2
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
E7-28 (E2) - A1-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
E6-32 (TAM) - A1-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
E7-28 (E2) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
E6-32 (TAM) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
ECM Connector Wire Harness View:
E7
E2
ECM Connector Wire Harness View:
E6
NG
TAM
I41016
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1327
05-1 138
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05ITU-01
B1413/13 EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the temperature inside the cooling unit and sends the appropriate signals to the A/C
amplifier assy.
DTC No.
B1413/13
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Cooler thermistor No. 1 ((Evaporator temperature sensor))
Harness or connector between cooler thermistor No. 1 and
A/C amplifier assy.
assy
A/C amplifier assy.
Open or short in evaporator temperature sensor circuit.
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier Assy
G-Y
6
IJ1
LG
5
A11 TE
LG-R
3
IJ1
P
12
A11 SG-1
2
E12
Cooler Thermistor No. 1
(Evaporator Temperature sensor)
1
I30339
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1328
05-1 139
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
In case of using the hand-held tester, start the inspection step 1 and in case of not using the hand-held
tester, start from step 2.
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the items below in the DATA LIST, and read the displays on the hand-held tester.
A C:
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
EVAP TEMP
Evaporator temperature sensor
/min.: -29.7C (-21.46F)
max.: 59.55C (139.19F)
Actual evaporator temperature
-
Result:
NG
A
OK (Checking from the DTC)
B
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOM TABLE)
C
B
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
C
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE(SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
A
2
INSPECT AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY(TE, SG-1)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
(b)
(c)
A11
TE (+)
SG-1 (-)
I30331
Remove A/C amplifier assy with connectors still connected.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A11-5 (TE) A11-12 (SG-1)
at 0C (32F)
2.0 to 2.4 V
A11-5 (TE) A11-12 (SG-1)
at 15C (59F)
1.4 to 1.8 V
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1329
05-1 140
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT COOLER THERMISTOR NO.1(EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
Cooler Thermistor
No.1 Connector
Front View:
E12
E50650
Remove cooler thermistor No. 1.
Check resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of cooler
thermistor No. 1 at each temperature, as shown in the
chart.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
E12-1 - E12-2
-10 °C (14°F)
7.40 to 9.20 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
-5 °C (23°F)
5.65 to 7.00 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
0°C (32°F)
4.35 to 5.40 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
5°C (41°F)
3.40 to 4.20 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
10°C (50°F)
2.68 to 3.30 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
15°C (59°F)
2.10 to 2.60 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
20°F (68°F)
1.66 to 2.10 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
25°C (77°F)
1.32 to 1.66 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
30°C (86°F)
1.05 to 1.35 kΩ
NOTICE:
Even slightly touching the sensor may change the resistance value. Be sure to hold the connector of the
sensor.
When measuring the sensor temperature must be the
same as the ambient temperature.
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the resistance decrease (see
the graph below).
10.0
9.0
8.0
7.0
Maximum permissible value line
6.0
Resistance
(kΩ)
5.0
4.0
3.0
2.0
Minimum permissible value line
1.0
0.0
-20
-4
0
32
40 (°C)
104 (°F)
20
68
Temperature
I38756
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1330
05-1 141
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NG
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
REPLACE
COOLER
THERMISTOR
NO.1(EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(COOLER THERMISTER NO.1
(EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR) - A/C AMPLIFIER ASSY)
(a)
Cooler Thermistor No.1 Connector
Wire Harness View:
E12
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A11-5 (TE) - E12-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-12 (SG-1) - E12-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-5 (TE) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11-12 (SG-1) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11
TE
SG-1
NG
I41012
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1331
05-1 142
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05ITV-01
B1421/21 SOLAR SENSOR CIRCUIT (PASSENGER
SIDE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Resistance of photodiode
High
A photo diode in the solar sensor detects solar radiation and
sends signals to the A/C amplifier assy.
Low
Weak
Strong
Strength of solar radiation
DTC No.
B1421/21
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Open or short in solar sensor circuit
circuit.
dis lay of DTC B1421/21 is not abnormal
(Please note that display
when the sensor is not receiving solar radiation.)
Cooler (solar
(
sensor)) thermistor
Harness or connector between Cooler (solar sensor) Thermistor and A/C amplifier assy
A/C amplifier assy
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier Assy
L
16
A11 TS
W
15
A11 S5-3
2
A12
Cooler (Solar sensor)
Thermistor
1
I30340
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1332
05-1 143
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
In case of using the hand-held tester, start the inspection step 1 and in case of not using the hand-held
tester, start from step 2.
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the items below in the DATA LIST, and read the displays on the hand-held tester.
A C:
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SOLAR SENS-P
Solar sensor (Passenger side)
/min.: 0 max.: 255
Changes depending on brightness
(Passenger side)
-
Result:
NG
A
OK (Checking from the DTC)
B
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOM TABLE)
C
B
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
C
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE(SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
A
2
INSPECT AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY(TS, S5-3)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
(b)
(c)
A11
TS (+)
S5-3 (-)
I30331
Remove A/C amplifier assy with connectors still connected.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A11-16 (TS) A11-15 (S5-3)
Sensor subject to electric
light
Below 4.0 V
A11-16 (TS) A11-15 (S5-3)
Sensor is covered by a
cloth
4.0 to 4.5 V
HINT:
As the inspection light is moved away from the sensor, the voltage increases.
Use an incandescent lamp for inspection. Bring it within 30 cm
(11.8 in.) of the solar sensor.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE(SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1333
05-1 144
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) THERMISTOR
(a)
(b)
Solar Sensor Connector
Front View:
(c)
A12
2
1
I30886
Remove the cooler (solar sensor) thermistor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Connect the negative (-) lead from the ohmmeter to terminal 1 and positive (+) lead to terminal 2 of the A/C solar
sensor.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A12-1 - A12-2
Sensor is subject to electric light
Except ∞ Ω
A12-1 - A12-2
Sensor is covered with a
cloth
∞ Ω (No continuity)
NOTICE:
The connection procedure for using a digital tester such as
an electrical tester is shown above. When using an analog
tester, connect the negative (-) lead to terminal 2 and positive (+) lead to terminal 1 of the A/C solar sensor.
HINT:
As the inspection light is moved away from the sensor, the
resistance increases.
Use an incandescent lamp for inspection. Bring it within
30 cm (11.8 in.) of the cooler (solar sensor) thermistor.
NG
REPLACE
COOLER
THERMISTOR
(SOLAR
SENSOR)
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1334
05-1 145
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) THERMISTOR
- A/C AMPLIFIER ASSY)
(a)
Cooler (Solar Sensor) Thermistor
Connector Wire Harness View:
A12
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A11-15 (S5-3) - A12-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-16 (TS) - A12-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-15 (S5-3) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11-16 (TS) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11
TS
S5-3
I41013
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1335
05-1 146
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05ITW-01
B1422/22 COMPRESSOR LOCK SENSOR CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM and A/C amplifier communicate via BEAN.
This sensor sends 4 pulses per engine revolution to the ECM.
If the number ratio of the compressor speed divided by the engine speed is smaller than a predetermined
value, the ECM turns the compressor OFF. And the indicator flashes at about 1 second intervals.
DTC No.
Detection Item
All conditions below are detected for 3 secs.
secs or more
(c) Engine speed: 450 rpm or more
(d) Ratio between engine and compressor speed deviates
20 % or more in comparison to normal operation.
operation
B1422/22
Trouble Area
Cooler compressor assy (A/C magnetic clutch and lock sensor)
Cooler com
compressor
ressor assy drive belt
Cooler compressor assy lock sensor
Harness and connector between cooler compressor assy and
ECM
Multiplex communication circuit
ECM
A/C amplifier assy
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
23
W-L
1
E9
LCK1
A2
Cooler
Compressor
Assy
2
BR
A
J7
J/C
A
BR (*2)
EE
BR (*1)
ED
*1: 3MZ-FE
*2: 2AZ-FE
I38769
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1336
05-1 147
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT ECM(LCK1)
(a)
(b)
ECM Connector Wire
Harness View:
E9
Remove the ECM with connectors still connected.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
E9-23 (LCK1) - Body
ground
Start engine A/C, switch
AUTO
Pulse generation
LCK1
I38774
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE(SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
NG
2
INSPECT COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY
Cooler Compressor Assy Connector
Front View:
A2
le 3 2
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the cooler compressor assy connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A2-1 - A2-2
at 20°C (68°F)
165 to 205 Ω
E05280
NG
REPLACE COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1337
05-1 148
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(ECM - COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY)
(a)
Cooler Compressor Assy
Connector Front view:
A2
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
E9-23(LCK1) - A2-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
E9-23 (LCK1) - Body
ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A2-2 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE
ECM Connector Wire
Harness View:
E9
LCK1
I41017
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1338
05-1 149
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05ITX-02
B1423/23 PRESSURE SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Low pressure side
High pressure side
ON (Below 1.0 Ω)
196 KPa
3,140 KPa
(2.0 kgf⋅cm2, 28 psi) (32.0 kgf⋅cm2, 455 psi)
OFF
OFF
(10 kΩ or higher) (10 kΩ or higher) I40666
DTC No.
B1423/23
The ECM and A/C amplifier communicate via BEAN.
The pressure switch sends the appropriate signals to the A/C
amplifier when the A/C refrigerant pressure drops too low or
rises too high. When the A/C amplifier receives these signals,
it outputs signals through the A/C amplifier to turn the magnet
clutch relay off and turns the magnetic clutch off.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Pressure switch
Harness or connector between cooler refrigerant liquid pipe A
(pressure switch) and ECM
Multiplex communication circuit
Refrigerant pipe line
ECM
A/C amplifier assy
Open in pressure sensor circuit.
Abnormal refrigerant pressure.
below 196 kPa (2.0 kg/cm2, 28 psi)
over 3,140 kPa (32.0 kgf/cm2, 455 psi)
WIRING DIAGRAM
A3
Pressure Switch
W-B
4
Dual
G
1
2
IK3
L
1
ECM
E6 HP
A
J2
J/C
EH
I41168
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1339
05-1 150
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
INSPECT REFRIGERANT PRESSURE
Set the manifold gauge.
Read the manifold gauge pressure when these conditions are established.
Test conditions:
Temperature at the air inlet with the switch set at RECIRC is 30 to 35°C (86 to 95°F)
Engine running at 1,500 rpm
Blower speed control switch at ”HI” position
Temperature control dial at ”COOL” position
Air conditioning switch ON
Fully open doors
Standard:
Pressure on high pressure side:
1.37 to 1.57 MPa (13.9 to 16.0 kgf⋅cm2, 198 to 228 psi)
HINT:
If the refrigerant pressure is below 196 KPa (2.0 kgf⋅cm2, 28 psi), the refrigerant amount in the air conditioning cycle may have decreased significantly for reasons such as a gas leakage.
NG
INSPECT AND REPAIR AIR CONDITIONING
CYCLE
OK
2
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING OPERATION
(a)
(b)
Pressure Switch Connector
Wire Harness View:
A3
(c)
(d)
(e)
I40669
Disconnect the pressure switch connector.
Connect terminals 1 and 4 of the connector of the pressure switch on the vehicle wire harness side using a service wire.
Start the engine.
Turn the air conditioning switch on and check that the
magnet clutch is turned on.
Check that the magnet clutch is turned off when disconnecting terminals 1 and 4 (that are connected in the prior
step).
OK:
Terminals 1 and 4 connected: magnet clutch is on
Terminals 1 and 4 disconnected: magnet clutch is off
NG
Go to step 3
OK
REPLACE PRESSURE SWITCH
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1340
05-1 151
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PRESSURE SWITCH - ECM)
(a)
Pressure Switch Connector
Front View:
A3
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
E6-1 (HP) - A3-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
A3-4 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
E6-1 (HP) - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A3-1 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Result:
ECM Connector
Wire Harness View:
E6
NG
A
OK
(Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
HP
I41169
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
A
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1341
05-1 152
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05ITY-01
B1431/31 AIR MIX DAMPER POSITION SENSOR
CIRCUIT (PASSENGER SIDE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the position of the air mix damper servo
sub-assy and sends the appropriate signals to the A/C amplifier assy. The position sensor is built into the air mix servo subassy.
TP terminal voltage (V)
4
1
0
Damper opening angle 100%
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
B1431/31
Short to ground or power source circuit in air mix damper position sensor circuit.
Air mix damper position sensor.
Harness or connector between air mix damper servo subassy and A/C amplifier assy.
A/C amplifier assy
WIRING DIAGRAM
A14 Air Mix Damper Servo Sub-assy
A/C Amplifier Assy
2
LG-R
3
IJ1
P
12
A11 SG-1
1
P-L
4
IJ1
O
11
A11 S5-1
3
O
5
IJ1
SB
5
Y-G
1
IJ1
B
14
A11 AMH
4
Y
2
IJ1
GR
13
A11 AMC
10
A11 TP
I30342
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1342
05-1 153
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
In case of using the hand-held tester, start the inspection step 1 and in case of not using the hand-held
tester, start from step 2.
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the items below in the DATA LIST, and read the displays on the hand-held tester.
A C:
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/M DAMP POS-P
Air mix damper position
(Passenger side)
/min.:-5% max.:105%
Changes depending on the set
temperature (Passenger side)
-
A/M DAMP TARG-P
Air mix damper target position
(Passenger side)
/min.:-5% max.:105%
Changes depending on the set
temperature (Passenger side)
-
Result:
NG
A
OK (Checking from the DTC)
B
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOM TABLE)
C
B
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
C
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
A
2
INSPECT AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY(TP, SG-1)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
(b)
(c)
A11
SG-1 (-)
TP (+)
I30331
Remove the A/C amplifier assy with connectors still connected.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A11-10 (TP) A11-12 (SG-1)
MAX. COOL
3.5 to 4.5 V
A11-10 (TP) A11-12 (SG-1)
MAX. WARM
0.5 to 1.8 V
HINT:
As the set temperature increases, the voltage decreases gradually without interruption.
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1343
05-1 154
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT AIRMIX DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY
(a)
(b)
Air Mix Damper Servo Sub-assy
Connector Wire Harness View:
A14
(c)
I30157
MAX. WARM
MAX. COOL
Remove the air mix damper servo sub-assy.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of air mix
damper servo sub-assy connector.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A14-1 - A14-2
Always
4.2 to 7.8 kΩ
While operating air mix damper servo sub-assy as shown
in the procedure on page 05-1 160, measure resistance
between terminals 1 and 3 of air mix damper servo subassy.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A14-1 - A14-3
MAX. COOL
3.4 to 6.2 kΩ
A14-1 - A14-3
MAX. WARM
0.8 to 1.6 kΩ
HINT:
As the air mix damper servo sub-assy moves from cool side to
warm side, the resistance decreases gradually without interruption.
I30332
Resistance (kΩ)
3.4 - 6.2
Arm position
0.8 - 1.6
MAX. COOL MAX. WARM
I30161
NG
REPLACE AIRMIX DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1344
05-1 155
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(AIR MIX DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY - A/C
AMPLIFIER ASSY)
(a)
Air Mix Damper Servo Sub-assy
Wire Harness View:
A14
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
A11
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A11-1 1 (S5-1) - A14-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-12 (SG-1) - A14-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-10 (TP) - A14-3
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-1 1 (S5-1) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11-12 (SG-1) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11-10 (TP) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
TP
SG-1
S5-1
NG
I41014
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1345
05-1 156
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05ITZ-02
B1433/33 AIR OUTLET DAMPER POSITION SENSOR
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the position of the mode damper servo
sub-assy and sends the appropriate signals to the A/C amplifier assy. The position sensor is built into the mode damper servo
sub-assy .
TPO terminal voltage
(V)
4
1
0
100%
Damper opening angle
DTC No.
B1433/33
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Short to ground or power source circuit in air outlet damper
position sensor circuit.
Mode damper position sensor (Air outlet damper position
sensor)
Harness or connector between mode damper servo subassy and A/C amplifier assy
A/C amplifier assy
WIRING DIAGRAM
A15 Mode Damper Servo Sub-assy
(Air Outlet Damper Position Sensor)
A/C Amplifier Assy
1
W
13
IL2
B
1
A11 SG-4
2
B
3
IL2
BR
9
A11 S5-4
3
G
14
IL2
R
6
A11 TPO
5
LG
15
IL2
V
8
A11 AOF
4
L
4
IL2
G
7
A11 AOD
I30342
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1346
05-1 157
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
In case of using the hand-held tester, start the inspection step 1 and in case of not using the hand-held
tester, start from step 2.
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the items below in the DATA LIST, and read the displays on the hand-held tester.
A C:
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/O DAMP POS
Air outlet damper position
/min.:-14% max.:113.5%
Changes depending on air outlet
power position
-
A/O DAMP TARG
Air outlet damper target position
/min.:-14% max.:113.5%
Changes depending on air outlet
power position
-
Result:
NG
A
OK (Checking from the DTC)
B
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOM TABLE)
C
B
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
C
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
A
2
INSPECT AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY(TPO, SG-4)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
(b)
(c)
A11
TPO (+)
SG-4 (-)
I30331
Remove the A/C amplifier assy with connectors still connected.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A11-6 (TPO) A11-1 (SG-4)
FACE
3.5 to 4.5 V
A11-6 (TPO) A11-1 (SG-4)
DEF
0.5 to 1.5 V
HINT:
As the air outlet servomotor is moved from FACE side to DEF
side, the voltage decreases gradually without interruption.
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1347
05-1 158
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT MODE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY
(a)
(b)
Mode Damper Servo Sub-assy
Connector Wire Harness View:
A15
(c)
I30157
Remove the mode damper servo sub-assy.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of mode
damper servo sub-assy connector.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A15-1 - A15-2
Always
4.2 to 7.8 kΩ
While operating mode damper servo sub-assy as in the
procedure on page 05-1 164, measure resistance between terminals 1 and 3 of mode damper servo sub-assy.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A15-1 - A15-3
DEF
3.4 to 6.2 kΩ
A15-1 - A15-3
FACE
0.8 to 1.6 kΩ
HINT:
As the mode damper servo sub-assy moves from DEF side to
FACE side, the resistance decreases gradually without interruption.
FACE
DEF
I30333
Resistance (kΩ)
3.4 -6.2
Arm Position
0.8 - 1.6
DEF
FACE
I30161
NG
REPLACE MODE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1348
05-1 159
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MODE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY - A/C
AMPIFIER ASSY)
(a)
Mode Damper Servo Sub- assy
Wire Harness View:
A15
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
A11
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A11-1 (SG-4) - A15-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-9 (S5-4) - A15-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-6 (TPO) - A15-3
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-1 (SG-4) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11-9 (S5-4) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11-6 (TPO) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
SG-4
TPO
S5-4
NG
I41014
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1349
05-1 160
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05IU0-01
B1441/41 AIR MIX DAMPER CONTROL SERVOMOTOR
CIRCUIT (PASSENGER SIDE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This air mix damper servo sub-assy is controlled by the A/C amplifier assy and moves the air mix damper
servo sub-assy to the desired position.
DTC No.
B1441/41
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Air mix dam
damper
er position
osition sensor value does not change even if
A/C am
amplifier
lifier assy o
operates
erates air mix dam
damper
er servo sub
sub-assy.
assy.
Air mix damper servo sub-assy
Harness or connector between air mix damper
dam er servo subassy and A/C am
amplifier
lifier assy
A/C amplifier assy
WIRING DIAGRAM
A14
Air Mix Damper Servo Sub-assy
A/C Amplifier Assy
2
LG-R
3
IJ1
P
12
A11 SG-1
1
P-L
4
IJ1
O
11
A11 S5-1
3
O
5
IJ1
SB
10
A11 TP
5
Y-G
1
IJ1
B
14
A11 AMH
4
Y
2
IJ1
GR
13
A11 AMC
I30342
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1350
05-1 161
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
PERFORM ACTUATOR CHECK
Set to actuator check mode (see page 05-1 117).
Press the DEF switch and change to step operation.
Check the air flow temperature by hand.
Display Code
Air Mix Damper Operation
0
COOL side (-5 % open)
1
COOL side (-5 % open)
2
COOL side (-5 % open)
3
COOL side (-5 % open)
4
COOL/WARM (50 % open)
5
COOL/WARM (50 % open)
6
WARM side (105 % open)
7
WARM side (105 % open)
8
WARM side (105 % open)
9
WARM side (105 % open)
OK:
Air flow temperature changes in accordance with
each display code.
Result:
NG
A
OK
(Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
C
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1351
05-1 162
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT AIRMIX DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY
(a)
(b)
Air Mix Damper Servo Sub-assy
Connector Wire Harness View:
(c)
A14
Remove the air mix damper servo sub-assy.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
4 and negative (-) lead to terminal 5, then check that the
lever turns to ”COOL” side smoothly.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
5 and negative (-) lead to terminal 4, then check that the
lever turns to ”WARM” side smoothly.
I30157
To ”WARM”
To ”COOL”
I30334
NG
REPLACE AIRMIX DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1352
05-1 163
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(AIR MIX DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY - A/C
AMPLIFIER ASSY)
(a)
Air Mix Damper Servo Sub- assy
Connector Wire Harness View:
A14
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A11-13 (AMC) - A14-4
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-14 (AMH) - A14-5
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-13 (AMC) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11-14 (AMH) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11
AMH
AMC
NG
I41014
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1353
05-1 164
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05IU1-01
B1443/43 AIR OUTLET DAMPER CONTROL
SERVOMOTOR CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit turns the servomotor and changes each mode damper position by the signals from the A/C amplifier assy. When the AUTO switch is on, the A/C amplifier assy changes the mode automatically between
(FACE), (BI-LEVEL) and (FOOT) according to the temperature setting.
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
B1443/43
Air outlet damper position sensor value does not change even
if A/C amplifier
lifi assy operates
t air
i mode
d d
damper servo subb
assy
assy.
Mode damper servo sub-assy.
Harness or connector between mode damper
dam er servo subassy and A/C am
amplifier
lifier assy.
A/C amplifier assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
A15
Mode Damper Servo Sub-assy
A/C Amplifier Assy
1
A11 SG-4
1
W
13
IL2
B
2
B
3
IL2
BR
3
G
14
IL2
R
6
A11 TPO
5
LG
15
IL2
V
8
A11 AOF
4
L
4
IL2
G
7
A11 AOD
9
A11
S5-4
I30342
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1354
05-1 165
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
PERFORM ACTUATOR CHECK
Warm up engine.
Set to actuator check mode (see page 05-1 117).
Press the DEF switch and change it to step operation
Press the DEF switch and check that the air flow by hand.
Display code
Air flow condition
0
FACE
1
FACE
2
FACE
3
FACE
4
FACE
5
B/L
6
FOOT
7
FOOT
8
FOOT/DEF
9
DEF
OK:
Air flow position changes in accordance with each
display code.
Result:
NG
A
OK
(Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
C
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1355
05-1 166
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT MODE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY
(a)
(b)
Mode Damper Servo Sub-assy
Connector Wire Harness View:
(c)
A15
Remove the air mode damper servo sub-assy.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
4 and negative (-) lead to terminal 5 then check that the
lever turns to ”DEF” position.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
5 and negative (-) lead to terminal 4 then check that the
lever turns to ”FACE” position.
I30157
To ”DEF”
To ”FACE”
I30335
NG
REPLACE MODE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1356
05-1 167
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MODE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY - A/C
AMPLIFIER ASSY)
(a)
Mode Damper Servo Sub- assy
Wire Harness View:
A15
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A11-8 (AOF) - A15-5
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-7 (AOD) - A15-4
Always
Below 1 Ω
A11-8 (AOF) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11-7 (AOD) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A11
AOD
AOF
NG
I41014
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1357
05-1 168
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
0522E-05
B1499/99 MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM and A/C amplifier communicate via BEAN.
This DTC is output when communication stops.
DTC No.
B1499/99
Detection Item
Trouble Area
O
Open
en in
i multiplex
multi
lti lex
l communication
i ti circuit
i it
M lti lex
Multiplex
Multi
l communication
i ti circuit
i it
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
A/C Amplifier
Assy
ECM
Body ECU
6
18
MPX1
W
E6
10
MPX1
B10
MPX2 B9
12
IL2
O
1
IB2
GR
8
MPX2
E6
GR
1
IL2
11
4 MPD1
MPD2
IF3
8
IB2
SB
P5
Power Window Master
SW With ECU
29
7
5
4F
4A
BR
2
1
S31
S31
Passenger Side J/B
9
SB
V
(*1)
5
Y
V
MPX2
MPX1 7
G5
Gateway ECU
G
(*1)
R
2
A11 MPX+
G (*2)
21
MPX+
C11
C12
MPXCombination Meter
Y
Short Connector
1
12
3E
3J
G
9
A10 MPX-
Center J/B
*1: w/ Navigation System
*2: w/o Navigation System
I38778
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1358
05-1 169
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
NG
GO TO MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1359
05-1 170
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05IU2-01
IG POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the power source for the A/C amplifier assy and servomotor, etc.
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier Assy
Instrument Panel J/B
I15
Ignition SW
2
Center J/B
4
G
AM1 IG1
7
1C
HEATER
6
1C
AM1
W
1
W
2
2
ALT
F7
Fusible
Link
Block
FL MAIN
Battery
13
1K
B
4
3A
7
3J
BR
13
6
3J
W-B
2
A10 IG
1
1A
1
B
W-B
3F
11
A10 GND
IB
I38766
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1360
05-1 171
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
CHECK FUSE(HEATER, AM1 FUSES)
Remove the HEATER and AM1 fuses from the instrument panel J/B.
Check that the continuity exists in HEATER and AM1 fuses.
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
INSPECT AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY(IG, GND)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
(b)
A10
GND (-)
IG (+)
I30331
Remove the A/C amplifier assy with connectors still connected.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A10-2 (IG) A10-11 (GND)
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
NG
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(A/C AMPLIFIER ASSY - BODY GROUND)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector Wire Harness View:
A10
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A10-11 (GND) Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND
I38763
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1361
05-1 172
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(A/C AMPLIFIER ASSY - BATTERY)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector Wire Harness View:
A10
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A10-2 (IG) Body ground
Ignition switch
OFF → ON
Below 1.0 V → 10 to 14 V
IG
I38763
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1362
05-1 173
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05IU3-01
BACK-UP POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the back-up power source for the A/C amplifier assy. Power is supplied even when the ignition switch
is off and is used for diagnostic trouble code memory, etc.
WIRING DIAGRAM
W
3
1
W
1
2I
D.C.C
ECU-B
A/C Amplifier Assy
Instrument Panel J/B
Engine Room J/B
4 W-L 5
2A
IC3
BR
10
1G
2
1K
W
12
A10 +B
F7
Fusible
Link
Block
FL MAIN
Battery
I30515
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1363
05-1 174
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
CHECK FUSE(ECU-B FUSE)
Remove the ECU-B fuse from the engine room J/B.
Check that the continuity exits of ECU-B fuse.
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
INSPECT AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY(+B)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
(b)
A10
+B (+)
I30331
Remove the A/C amplifier assy with connectors still connected.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A10-12 (+B) Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
NG
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(A/C AMPLIFIER ASSY - BATTERY)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector Wire Harness View:
(b)
A10
GND
+B
I38763
Remove the A/C amplifier assy and disconnect the connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A10-12 (+B) A10-11 (GND)
Always
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1364
05-1 187
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05IU7-03
HEATER RELAY CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The heater relay is switched on by signals from the A/C amplifier assy. It supplies power to the blower motor.
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier Assy
Instrument Panel J/B
I15
Ignition SW
2 AM1 IG1 4 G
7
1C
HEATER 10A
6
1C
W
AM1
2
8
1G
Y
A
Y
1
W
B
2
W
1
ALT
HEATER 50A
7
BR
A 3
1
1A
1
H9
Heater
Relay
J5
J/C
1 IK4
2
IL2
O
7
A10 HR
5
From Blower
B
Motor
2
4 Passenger Side J/B
7
7
4L
4H
W-B
B-Y
F7
Fusible Link Block
W-B
FL MAIN
IC
Battery
I40780
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1377
05-1 188
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK FUSE(15 A HEATER, 50 A HEATER, AM1 FUSES)
Remove the 15 A HEATER and AM1 fuses from the instrument panel J/B.
Remove the 50 A HEATER fuse from fusible link block.
Check that the continuity exists in 15 A HEATER and 50 A HEATER, AM1 fuses.
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
3
INSPECT HEATER BLOWER MOTOR RELAY ASSY
4
(a)
5
3
1
1
5
4
(b)
2
2
Z19533
Check that the continuity exists between each pair of terminals of heater blower motor relay assy, as shown in the
chart.
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2-1
Always
10 kΩ or higher
2-4
Always
Below 1.0 Ω
Check continuity between each pair of terminals, as
shown the chart.
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2-1
When battery voltage applied to terminals 3 and 5
Below 1.0 Ω
2-4
When battery voltage applied to terminals 3 and 5
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE HEATER BLOWER MOTOR RELAY
ASSY
OK
3
INSPECT AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY(HR)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
(b)
A10
HR
I30331
Remove the A/C amplifier assy with connectors still connected.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A10-7 (HR) Body ground
Ignition switch OFF
0V
A10-7 (HR) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Blower switch ON
Below 1.0 V
A10-7 (HR) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Blower switch OFF
10 to 14 V
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1378
05-1 189
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector Wire Harness View:
A10
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A10-7 (HR) Body ground
Ignition switch
OFF → ON
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
HR
I38763
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1379
05-1 190
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05IU8-01
COMPRESSOR CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM and A/C amplifier communicate via BEAN.
The A/C amplifier assy outputs the magnetic clutch ON signal to the ECM.
Receiving this signal, the ECM sends a signal through terminal ACMG and switches the magnetic clutch
relay ON, thus turning on the magnetic clutch.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
From
Battery
Y
7
B-R
IK2
Engine Room J/B
8 Magnetic Clutch Relay 2
1
2
2A
2C
5
3
3
2E
From Fan No. 3
Relay
18
Y-G
O
IK3
Y-G
2
E6 ACMG
9
EB2
B-Y
3
A2
A/C Magnetic
Clutch and
Lock Sensor
I30520
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1380
05-1 191
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the items below in the DATA LIST, and read the displays on the hand-held tester.
ENGINE AND ECT / ALL:
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/C SIG
A/C signal/ ON or OFF
A/C ON: ON
-
A/C MAG CLUTCH
A/C magnet clutch/ ON or OFF
A/C magnet clutch ON: ON
-
NG
INSPECT
CIRCUIT
MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION
OK
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item below in the ACTIVE TEST, and then check that the relay operates.
ENGINE AND ECT / ALL:
Item
Test Details/Display (Range)
Diagnostic Note
A/C MAG CLUTCH
Magnetic clutch relay / OFF, ON
Operating sound can be heard
NG
Go to step 3
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE PAGE
05-1 129)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1381
05-1 192
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT MAGNET-CLUTCH RELAY
(a)
Remove the relay (magnet clutch relay) from the engine
room R/B.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
3
2
(b)
1
5
3
1
2
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
3-5
Always
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
When battery voltage applied to terminals 1 and 2
Below 1 Ω
5
Z18060
NG
REPLACE MAGNET-CLUTCH RELAY
OK
4
INSPECT MAGNET CLUTCH ASSY
(a)
(b)
Magnet Clutch Assy Connector
From View:
Disconnect the connector from the magnet clutch assy.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3 and negative (-) lead to body ground, then check that
the magnet clutch assy is engaged.
A2
E05280
le 3 2
NG
REPLACE MAGNET CLUTCH ASSY
OK
5
INSPECT ECM
(a)
(b)
ECM Connector Wire Harness View:
E6
Remove the ECM and disconnect the connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
E6-2 (ACMG) - Body
ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
I36159
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1382
05-1 193
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
(a)
(b)
ECM Connector
Wire Harness View:
E6
Disconnect the connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A2-3 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
When using service wire,
terminal E6-2 (ACMG)
and Body ground are not
connect
Below 1 V
A2-3 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
When using service wire,
terminal E6-2 (ACMG)
and Body ground are connect
10 to 14 V
ACMG
Magnet Clutch Assy Connector
Wire Harness View:
A2
I36159
E51630
I38853
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1383
05-1 181
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05IU6-01
BLOWER MOTOR CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Blower Level
The blower motor is operated by signals from the A/C amplifier
assy. Blower motor speed signals are transmitted by changes
in the Duty Ratio.
Duty Ratio
The duty ratio is the ratio of the period of continuity in one cycle.
For example, if A is the period of continuity in one cycle, B is the
period of non-continuity.
HI
M3
M2
M1
LO
0
29
41 53 67 89
Si duty (%)
Duty Ratio =
A
A+B
x 100 (%)
A
ON
OFF
B
1 cycle
WIRING DIAGRAM
B6
Blower Motor
1
2
A/C Amplifier Assy
B7
Blower Motor Control
R
VM
4
SI
P-L
2
1
IH1
W
5
IL2
LG
17
A10 BLW
B
B
2
IH1
B
B
3
+B
GND
1
W-B
From
H9
Heater
Relay
3 IH1
W-B
IA
I30519
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1371
05-1 182
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
PERFORM ACTUATOR CHECK
Set the actuator check mode (see page 05-1 117).
Press the blower switch to change to the step operation.
Check the air flow level by hand.
Display Code
Blower level
0
0
1
1
2
14
3
14
4
14
5
14
6
14
7
14
8
14
9
31
OK:
Blower level changes in accordance with each display code.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE PAGE
05-1 129)
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER - A/C
AMPLIFIER)
(a)
Blower Motor Controller Connector
Front View:
B7
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A10-17 (BLW) B7-2 (SI)
Always
Below 1 Ω
A10-17 (BLW) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
SI
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
A10
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
I41004
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1372
05-1 183
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER - BODY
GROUND)
(a)
Blower Motor Controller Connector
Front View:
B7
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B7-1 (GND) Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
GND
E69146
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
4
INSPECT COOLING UNIT MOTOR SUB-ASSY W/FAN
Blower w/ Fan Motor Sub-assy
Front View:
+
E68546
B6
-
E69147
(a)
(b)
Remove the blower w/ fan motor sub-assy.
Connect positive (+) lead to terminal 2 of the blower motor
connector and negative (-) lead to terminal 1.
Standard: Blower motor operates smoothly.
NG
REPLACE COOLING UNIT MOTOR SUB-ASSY
W/FAN
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1373
05-1 184
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK A/C SUB NO.2 WIRE
(a)
A/C Sub No.2 Wire Connector
Front View:
Wire to wire
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
IH1-2 - B6-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
IH1-2 - B7-3 (+B)
Always
Below 1 Ω
B6-2 - B7-3 (+B)
Always
Below 1 Ω
IH1
A/C Sub No.2 Wire Connector
Front View:
B7
+B
A/C Sub No.2 Wire Connector
Front View:
B6
I41008
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE A/C SUB NO.2 WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1374
05-1 185
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER BLOWER MOTOR)
(a)
Blower Motor Controller Connector
Front View:
B7
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B7-4 (VM) - B6-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
B7-4 (VM) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
VM
Blower Motor Connector Front View:
B6
NG
I36240
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1375
05-1 186
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER(BLW - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
(c)
A10
A/C Amplifier
Connector
Wire Harness View:
Remove the A/C amplifier with the connectors still connected.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Turn the blower switch on (Lo).
BLW
I38764
(d)
2V/
Division
Measure the waveform between terminal BLW (A10-17)
of the A/C amplifier and body ground.
OK:
Waveform operates as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Waveform varies with the blower level.
GND
500m sec./ Division
I31456
NG
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
OK
REPLACE BLOWER MOTOR CONTROL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1376
05-1 177
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05IU5-02
RECIRCULATION DAMPER SERVOMOTOR CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The A/C amplifier assy controls the recirculation damper servo sub-assy and moves it to the desired position.
WIRING DIAGRAM
A13
Recirculation Damper Servo Sub-assy
(Air Inlet Control Servo Motor)
A/C Amplifier Assy
5
Y
4
A10 MR/F
2
W
6
A10 AIF
1
B
5
A10 AIR
I30344
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1367
05-1 178
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
PERFORM ACTUATOR CHECK
Remove the glove box to see and check the recirculation damper servo sub-assy operation.
Set to the actuator check mode (see page 05-1 117).
Press the DEF switch and change it to step operation.
Press the DEF switch in order and check the operation of recirculation damper servo sub-assy.
Display code
Recirculation damper position
0
FRESH
1
FRESH
2
FRESH
3
FRESH
4
RECIRCULATION
5
RECIRCULATION
6
RECIRCULATION
7
RECIRCULATION
8
RECIRCULATION
9
RECIRCULATION
OK:
Recirculation damper position changes in accordance with each display code.
Result:
NG
A
OK
(Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
C
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1368
05-1 179
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT RECIRCULATION DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY(AIR INLET CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR)
Recirculation Damper Servo Sub-assy
Connector Wire Harness View:
(a)
(b)
(c)
A13
Remove the recirculation damper servo sub-assy.
Connect the positive (+) lead to from the battery to terminal 5 and negative (-) lead to terminal 2, then check that
the lever turns to ”FRESH” side smoothly.
Connect the positive (+) lead to from the battery to terminal 1 and negative (-) lead to terminal 5, then check that
the lever turns to ”RECIRCULATION” side smoothly.
I30157
To ”FRESH”
To ”RECIRCULATION”
I30336
NG
REPLACE RECIRCULATION DAMPER SERVO
SUB-ASSY(AIR INLET CONTROL SERVO
MOTOR)
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1369
05-1 180
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(RECIRCULATON DAMPER SERVO
SUB-ASSY (AIR INLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR) - A/C AMPLIFIER ASSY)
(a)
Recirculation Damper Servo Subassy Wire Harness View:
A13
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
A10
AIF
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A10-4 (MR/F) - A13-5
Always
Below 1 Ω
A10-6 (AIF) - A13-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
A10-5 (AIR) - A13-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
A10-4 (MR/F) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A10-6 (AIF) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
A10-5 (AIR) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
MR/F
NG
AIR
I41014
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1370
05-1 175
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05IU4-01
ACC POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit supplies power to the A/C amplifier assy. It supplies power to the illumination for the clock.
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Amplifier Assy
I15
Ignition SW
ACC 3 L
2
AM1
W
1
W
Instrument Panel J/B
3
2 RADIO NO. 2
1K
1C
6
1C
AM1
2
2
1
Center J/B
V
13
3A 4
11
3I
GR
13
A10 ACC
1
1A
B
ALT
F7
Fusible Link Block
FL MAIN
Battery
I40781
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1365
05-1 176
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
CHECK FUSE(RADIO NO. 2, AM1 FUSES)
Remove the RADIO No. 2 and AM1 fuses from the instrument panel J/B.
Check that the continuity exits in RADIO No. 2 and AM1 fuses.
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
INSPECT AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY(ACC)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector
Wire Harness View:
(b)
A10
ACC
I30331
Remove the A/C amplifier assy with connectors still connected.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A10-13 (ACC) Body ground
Ignition switch ACC
10 to 14 V
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE
PAGE 05-1 129)
NG
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(A/C AMPLIFIER ASSY - BATTERY)
(a)
A/C Amplifier Connector Wire Harness View:
(b)
A10
GND
ACC
I38763
Remove the A/C amplifier assy and disconnect the connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A10-13 (ACC) A10-11 (GND)
Always
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1366
05-1 116
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
0521Y-03
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
VIN
Customer’s Name
Production Data
Licence Plate No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
/
Date of Problem Occurrence
/
How Often does Problem Occur?
Continuous
Weather
Fine
Outdoor Temperature
Hot
Symptoms
km
miles
Odometer Reading
Intermittent
Cloudy
Warm
/
Snowy
Cool
(
times a day)
Various / Other
Cold (Approx.
°F
°C
)
Air Flow Control is
Faulty
Blower motor does not operate
Blower motor speed does not change
(Always Hi, Always Med, Always Lo)
Temperature
Control is Faulty
Cabin temperature does not go down
Cabin temperature does not rise
Response is slow
Air Inlet Control is
Faulty
Cannot change between FRS and REC
(Always Fresh or always Recirculating)
Vent Control is
Faulty
Mode does not change
Unable to enter the desired mode
1st Time
Normal System Code Malfunction Code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal System Code Malfunction Code (Code
)
DTC Check
I30150
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1306
05-1 125
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05220-03
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check (sensor check), check the circuit listed for that code
in the table below (Proceed to the page given for that circuit).
DTC No.
(See Page)
00
Detection Item
Normal
Room temperature sensor circuit
B1411/11*1
(05-1130)
Ambient temperature sensor circuit
B1412/12*2
(05-1134)
Evaporator temperature sensor circuit
B1413/13
(05-1138)
Solar sensor circuit (short)
B1421/21*3
(05-1142)
Memory*4
-
-
Cooler (room temperature sensor) thermistor
Harness or connector between cooler (room temperature
sensor) thermistor and A/C amplifier assy
A/C amplifier assy
(8.5 min. or more)
Cooler (ambient temperature sensor) thermistor
Harness or connector between cooler (ambient temperature
sensor) thermistor and ECM
ECM
A/C amplifier assy
(8.5 min. or more)
Cooler thermistor No. 1 (Evaporator temperature sensor)
Harness or connector between cooler thermistor No. 1 sensor and A/C amplifier assy
A/C amplifier assy
(8.5 min. or more)
Cooler (solar sensor) thermistor
Harness or connector between cooler (solar sensor) thermistor and A/C amplifier assy
A/C amplifier assy
(8.5 min. or more)
Cooler (solar sensor) thermistor
Harness or connector between A/C solar sensor and A/C
amplifier assy
A/C amplifier assy
-
All conditions below are detected for 3
sec. or more
(a) Engine speed: 450 rpm or more
(b) Ratio between engine and compressor rpm deviates 20% or more in comparison to normal operation.
Cooler compressor assy
Cooler compressor assy drive belt
Cooler compressor assy lock sensor
Harness and connector between ECM and cooler compressor assy, cooler compressor assy and body ground
Multiplex communication circuit
ECM
A/C amplifier assy
-
Pressure switch circuit
Pressure switch
Harness or connector between pressure switch and ECM
Multiplex communication circuit
ECM
A/C amplifier assy
-
Air mix damper position sensor
Harness or connector between air mix damper servo subassy and A/C amplifier assy
A/C amplifier assy
(1 min. or more)
Mode damper position sensor
Harness or connector between mode damper servo subassy and A/C amplifier assy
A/C amplifier assy
(1 min. or more)
Air mix damper servo sub-assy
Air mix damper position sensor
Harness or connector between air mix damper servo subassy and A/C amplifier assy
A/C amplifier assy
(15 sec.)
Solar sensor circuit (open)
B1421/21*3
(05-1142)
B1422/22*5
(05-1146)
Trouble Area
B1423/23
(05-1149)
Air mix damper position sensor circuit
B1431/31
(05-1152)
Air outlet damper position sensor circuit
B1433/33
(05-1156)
Air mix control servo motor circuit
B1441/41
(05-1160)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1315
05-1 126
DIAGNOSTICS
Air outlet control servo motor circuit
B1443/43
(05-1164)
B1499/99
(05-1168)
Multiplex communication circuit
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Mode damper servo sub-assy
Mode damper position sensor
Harness or connector between mode damper servo subassy and A/C amplifier assy
A/C amplifier assy
Open in multiplex communication circuit
(15 sec.)
-
HINT:
*1:
If the room temperature is approx. -18.6°C (-1.48°F) or lower, DTC B1411/11 may be output even
though the system is normal.
*2: If the ambient temperature is approx. -52.9°C (-63.22°F) or lower, DTC B1412/12 may be output
even though the system is normal.
*3: If the check is being performed in a dark place, DTC B1421/21 (solar sensor circuit abnormal) could
be displayed.
*4: The A/C amplifier assy memorizes the DTC of the respective malfunction it has occurred for the
period of the time indicated in the brackets.
*5: Compressor lock (DTC B1422/22) is indicated only for a current malfunction. (see page 05-1 146)
To confirm DTC B1422/22, perform the following steps.
(1) With the engine ON, enter the DTC check mode.
(2) Press the R/F switch to enter actuator check mode, and set the operation to Step No. 3.
(3) Press the AUTO switch to return to DTC check mode.
(4) The DTC is displayed after approximately 3 seconds.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1316
05-1 114
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
0521X-03
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORK SHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS (SEE PAGE 05-1 116)
3
CHECK AND CLEAR DTC (SEE PAGE 05-1 117)
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
SYMPTOM DOES NOT OCCUR (GO TO
STEP 5)
SYMPTOM OCCURS (GO TO STEP 8)
5
SYMPTOM SIMULATION (SEE PAGE 01-26 )
6
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM DTC
OUTPUTS (PROCEED TO ’’MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM)
NO MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC (GO TO STEP 7)
7
CHECK BEAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
BEAN DTC OUTPUTS (PROCEED TO ’’COMMUNICATION SYSTEM’’)
NO BEAN DTC (GO TO STEP 8)
8
DTC CHECK (OTHER THAN MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM DTC)
MALFUNCTION CODE (GO TO STEP 9)
NORMAL CODE (GO TO STEP 10)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1304
05-1 115
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC CHART (SEE PAGE 05-1 125)
GO TO STEP 10
10
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE PAGE 05-1 129)
11
ACTUATOR CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1 117)
12
CIRCUIT INSPECTION (SEE PAGE 05-1 130 - 05-1 190)
13
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
14
PARTS INSPECTION
15
REPAIR
16
CONFIRMATION TEST
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1305
05-1 127
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05221-03
LOCATION
Engine Room J/B
Magnetic Clutch Relay
ECU-B Fuse
50 A HEATER Fuse
Condenser
Pressure Switch
Ambient Temperature Sensor
Compressor and Magnetic Clutch
I30305
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1317
05-1 128
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
w/o Navigation System:
Instrument Panel J/B
15 A HEATER Fuse
RADIO No. 2 Fuse
AM1 Fuse
w/ Navigation System:
Multi Display Assy
Solar Sensor
Heater Control Assembly
A/C Amplifier Assy
Room Temperature Sensor
Evaporator
Air Outlet Damper Control Servomotor
Evaporator Temperature Sensor
Expansion Valve
Recirculation Damper Servomotor
Heater Radiator
Blower Motor
Blower Motor Linear Controller
Air Mix Damper Control Servomotor
I41028
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1318
05-1 117
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05IU9-01
PRE-CHECK
1.
LIST OF OPERATION METHODS
By operating each of the A/C control switches as shown in the diagram below, it is possible to enter the diagnosis check mode.
Turn igniton switch ON with AUTO
and R/F switches held down.
If both AUTO switch and R/F switches are
not pressed at the same time.
Indicator Check
OFF
DTC Check
(Sensor Check)
(continuous operation)
R/F
Actuator Check
(continuous operaiton)
AUTO
DEF
OFF
DTC Check
(Sensor Check)
(stepped operation)
R/F
R/F
AUTO
OFF
DEF
Actuator Check
(stepped operation)
OFF
AUTO
DEF
DEF
Cancel check mode and start A/C control.
: Indicates a switch operation
R/F: Recirculation/Fresh
2.
(a)
w/o Navigation System
INDICATOR CHECK
Turn the ignition switch ON while pressing the A/C control
AUTO switch and R/F switch simultaneously.
I30328
w/ Navigation System
I38758
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1307
05-1 118
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
w/o Navigation System
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Check that the indicators light up and go off at 1 second
intervals 4 times in succession.
HINT:
After the indicator check is completed, the system enters
the DTC automatically.
Press the OFF switch when desiring to cancel the check
mode.
I41003
w/ Navigation System
I38757
1 Sec.
1 Sec.
ON
OFF
I36113
w/o Navigation System
3.
(a)
DTC
(b)
DTC CHECK (SENSOR CHECK)
Perform an indicator check. After the indicator check is
completed, the system enters the DTC check mode automatically.
Read the code displayed on the panel. Refer to the list of
codes on page 05- 1125 when reading the codes.
(Trouble codes are output at the temperature display.)
I30327
w/ Navigation System
DTC
I38759
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1308
05-1 119
DIAGNOSTICS
w/o Navigation System
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(c)
If the slower display is desired, press the FRONT DEF
switch and change it to stepped operation. Each time the
FRONT DEF switch is pressed, the display changes by 1
step.
4.
(a)
CLEARING DTC
To clear diagnostic trouble code, there are 2 ways.
(1) During sensor check, press the FRONT DEF switch
and REAR DEF switch at the same time.
(2) Pull the ECU-B fuse in engine room J/B for 20 sec.
or longer to clear the DTC memory.
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
DTC CHECK USING HAND-HELD TESTER
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Power switch ON (ready).
Read the DTC following the prompts on the tester screen.
Please refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual
for further details.
Clear the DTCs.
I30328
w/ Navigation System
I38758
Engine Room J/B
ECU-B Fuse
I30337
F46779
(d)
HINT:
After repairing the malfunctions, clear the DTC.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Erase the DTCs following the prompts on the tester
screen.
HINT:
Refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1309
05-1 120
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
6.
(a)
w/o Navigation System
I30329
w/ Navigation System
ACTUATOR CHECK
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position while pressing
the A/C control AUTO switch and R/F (Recirculation /
Fresh) switch simultaneously.
(b) As each damper, motor and relay automatically operate
the actuator check at 1 second intervals from step No.1
to No.10 continuously, check the temperature and air flow
visually and by hand.
If a slower display is desired, press the temperature up switch
and change the display in the step operation. Each time the
temperature up switch is pressed, the display changes by 1
step.
HINT:
Codes are displayed from the smaller to the larger numbers in order.
To cancel the check mode, press the ”OFF” switch.
I38758
4
Conditions
Display
code
Blower level
1
0
0
FACE
FRESH
OFF
”COOL” side
(Fully closed)
2
1
1
FACE
FRESH
OFF
”COOL” side
(Fully closed)
3
2
17
FACE
FRESH
ON
”COOL” side
(Fully closed)
4
3
17
FACE
FRESH
ON
”COOL” side
(Fully closed)
5
4
17
FACE
RECIRCULATION
ON
”COOL”/ ”WARM ”
(50% open)
6
5
17
B/L
RECIRCULATION
ON
”COOL”/ ”WARM ”
(50% open)
7
6
17
FOOT
RECIRCULATION
ON
”WARM” side
(Fully opened)
8
7
17
FOOT
RECIRCULATION
ON
”WARM” side
(Fully opened)
9
8
17
FOOT/ DEF
RECIRCULATION
ON
”WARM” side
(Fully opened)
10
9
31
DEF
RECIRCULATION
ON
”WARM” side
(Fully opened)
Step No.
Air flow vent
Air inlet damper
Magnetic clutch
Air mix damper
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1310
05-1 121
DIAGNOSTICS
7.
(a)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK DLC3
The vehicle’s ECM uses ISO 9141-2 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies with
SAEJ1962 and matches the ISO 9141-2 format.
9 10111213141516
DLC3
A04550
Terminal No.
Connection/Voltage or Resistance
Condition
7
Bus + Line/Pulse generation
During transmission
4
Chassis Ground - Body Ground/1 Ω or less
Always
5
Signal Ground - Body Ground/1 Ω or less
Always
16
Battery Positive - Body Ground/9 to 14 V
Always
8.
DATA LIST
HINT:
From the DATA LIST displayed on the hand-held tester, you can read the values of the displays, sensors,
actuators and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of troubleshooting is
one way to shorten labor time.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) From the display on the tester, select the ”DATA LIST”.
ALL:
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/C SIG
A/C signal / ON or OFF
A/C ON: ON
-
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ROOM TEMP
Room temperature sensor
/min.: -6.5C (20.3F)
max.: 57.25C (135.05F)
Actual room temperature
-
AMBI TEMP SENS
Ambient temperature sensor
/min.: -23.3C (-9.94F)
max.: 65.95C (150.71F)
Actual ambient temperature
-
AMBI TEMP
Adjusted ambient temperature
/min.: -30.8C (-23.44F)
max.: 50.8C (123.44F)
Actual ambient temperature
-
EVAP TEMP
Evaporator temperature sensor
/min.: -29.7C (-21.46F)
max.: 59.55C (139.19F)
Actual evaporator temperature
-
SOLAR SENS-D
Solar sensor (Driver side)
/min.: 0 max.: 255
Changes depending on brightness
(Driver side)
-
COOLANT TEMP
Engine coolant temperature
/min.: 1.3C (34.34F)
max.: 90.55C (194.99F)
Actual engine coolant temperature
-
SET TEMP-D
Set temperature
(Driver side)
/min.: 0 max.: 255
Actual set temperature
(Driver side)
-
A/M DAMP POS-D
Air mix damper position
(Driver side)
/min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Changes depending on the set
temperature (Driver side)
-
A C:
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1311
05-1 122
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/O DAMP POS
Air outlet damper position
/min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Changes depending on air outlet
power position
-
A/M DAMP TARG-D
Air mix damper target position
(Driver side)
/min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Changes depending on the set
temperature (Driver side)
-
A/O DAMP TARG
Air outlet damper target position
/min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Changes depending on air outlet
power position
-
BLOWER LEVEL
Blower motor speed level
/min.: Level 0 max.: Level 31
Changes depending on blower level
-
#CODES
Number of Trouble Codes
/min.: 0 max.: 255
-
-
HAND FREE TEL
Hands free telephone / OFF, ON
-
-
SET TEMP SHIFT
Shift set temperature/2C decr, 1C
decr, NORMAL, 1C incr, 2C incr
Changes depending on shift set
temperature *1
-
COMPRESSOR MODE
Compressor mode
/AUTO, MANUAL
Changes depending on compressor mode *1
-
COMPRS/DEF OPER
Compressor/DEF operation mode
/LINK, NORMAL
Changes depending on compressor/DEF operation mode *1
-
HINT:
*1: It differs depending on the user setting.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1312
05-1 129
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05223-03
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Whole functions of the A/C system does not operate.
1. IG power source circuit
2. A/C amplifier assy
05-1170
01-36
Air Flow Control: No blower operation
1. Heater relay circuit
2. Blower motor circuit
3. A/C amplifier assy
05-1187
05-1181
01-36
Air Flow Control: No blower control
1. Blower motor circuit
05-1181
Air Flow Control: Insufficient air output
1. Blower motor circuit
2. A/C amplifier assy
05-1181
01-36
1. Volume of refrigerant
2. Drive belt tension
3. Refrigerant pressure
4. Compressor circuit
5. Compressor lock sensor circuit
6. Pressure switch circuit
7. Air mix control servomotor circuit
8. Air mix damper position sensor circuit
9. Room temperature sensor circuit
10.Ambient temperature sensor circuit
11.A/C amplifier assy
55-11
19-12
19-36
55-11
05-1190
05-1146
05-1149
05-1160
05-1152
05-1130
05-1134
01-36
Temperature Control: No warm air comes out
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Air mix control servomotor circuit
Air mix damper position sensor circuit
Ambient temperature sensor circuit
Room temperature sensor circuit
Evaporator temperature sensor circuit
A/C amplifier assy
Heater radiator
05-1160
05-1152
05-1134
05-1130
05-1138
01-36
-
Temperature Control: Output air is warmer or cooler than the set
temperature or response is slow.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Room temperature sensor circuit
Ambient temperature sensor circuit
Solar sensor circuit
Air mix damper position sensor circuit
Air mix control servomotor circuit
A/C amplifier assy
05-1130
05-1134
05-1142
05-1152
05-1160
01-36
Temperature Control: No temperature control
(only Max. cool or Max. warm)
1. Air mix control servomotor circuit
2. Air mix damper position sensor circuit
3. A/C amplifier assy
05-1160
05-1152
01-36
No air inlet control
1. Recirculation damper control servomotor circuit
2. A/C amplifier assy
05-1177
01-36
No air outlet control
1. Air outlet damper position sensor circuit
2. Air outlet control servomotor circuit
3. A/C amplifier assy
05-1156
05-1164
01-36
Engine idle up does not occur, or is continuous.
1. Compressor circuit
2. Compressor lock sensor circuit
3. A/C amplifier assy
05-1190
05-1146
01-36
Set temperature value displayed does not match up with operation
of temperature control switch.
1. A/C amplifier assy
01-36
Brightness does not change when rheostat volume or light control
switch is turned.
1. Illumination light system
2. A/C amplifier assy
01-36
Unable to access the diagnosis mode
1. A/C amplifier assy
DTC not recorded. Set mode is cleared when IG switch is turned
off.
1. Back-up power source circuit
2. A/C amplifier assy
Temperature Control: No cool air comes out
2AZ-FE
3MZ-FE
01-36
05-1173
01-36
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1319
05-1 123
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
05IUA-02
TERMINALS OF ECU
A/C AMPLIFIER
A/C Amplifier
Wire Harness View:
A11
A10
8 76 5 4 3 2 1
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2221 2019 1817161514 13 12
16151413121110 9
I30330
Terminal No. (Symbols)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
0 → 10 to 14 V
A10-2 (IG) - A10-11 (GND)
BR - W-B
Main power supply
Ignition switch:
LOCK or ACC → ON
A10-4 (MR/F) - A10-6 (AIF)
Y-W
Recirculation damper
servomotor operation signal
Ignition switch: ON
R/F switch: RECIRCULATION →
FRESH
Below 1.0 → 10 to 14 V
A10-5 (AIR) - A10-4 (MR/F)
B-Y
Recirculation damper
servomotor operation signal
Ignition switch: ON
R/F switch: FRESH →
RECIRCULATION
Below 1.0 → 10 to 14 V
A10-7 (HR) - A10-11 (GND)
O - W-B
Blower speed operation
signal
Ignition switch: ON
Blower switch: ON → OFF
Below 1.0 → 10 to 14 V
A10-9 (MPX-) A10-11 (GND)
G - W-B
Multiplex communication
signal
Ignition switch: ON
Pulse generate
A10-11 (GND) - Body ground
W-B - Body
ground
Ground for main power
supply
Always
Below 1.0 Ω
A10-12 (+B) - A10-11 (GND)
W - W-B
Back up power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
A10-13 (ACC) - A10-11 (GND)
GR -W-B
Power supply for accessories
Ignition switch: LOCK → ON
0 → 10 to 14 V
A10-17 (BLW) - A10-11 (GND)
LG - W-B
Blower speed operation
signal
Ignition switch: ON
Blower switch: OFF →
LO, M1, M2, M3, HI
Pulse generate
A11-4 (TR) - A11-3 (SG-3)
W- Y
Room temperature sensor
signal
Ignition switch: ON
Cabin temperature:
40C (104F) → 25C (77F)
1.2 to 1.6 →
1.8 to 2.2 V
A11-5 (TE) - A11-12 (SG-1)
LG -P
Evaporator temperature
sensor signal
Ignition switch: ON
Evaporator temperature:
15C (59F) → 0C (32F)
1.4 to 1.8 →
2.0 to 2.4 V
A11-6 (TPO) - A11-12 (SG-1)
R-P
Mode damper servomotor
operation signal
Ignition switch: ON
R/F switch: DEF → FACE
0.5 to 1.5 →
3.5 to 4.5 V
A11-7 (AOD) - A10-11 (GND)
G -W-B
Mode damper servomotor
operation signal
Ignition switch: ON
Mode switch: FACE → DEF
Below 1.0 → 10 to 14 V
A11-8 (AOF) - A10-11 (GND)
V - W-B
Mode damper servomotor
operation signal
Ignition switch: ON
Mode switch: DEF → FACE
Below 1.0 → 10 to 14 V
A11-9 (S5-4) - A10-11 (GND)
BR - W-B
Ignition switch signal
Ignition switch: ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
A11-10 (TP) - A10-11 (GND)
SB - W-B
Air mix damper servomotor operation signal
Ignition switch: ON
Set temperature:
MAX. WARM → MAX. COOL
0.5 to 1.5 →
3.5 to 4.5 V
A11-1 1 (S5-1) A11-12 (SG-1)
O-P
Power supply for air mix
control servomotor
Ignition switch: ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
A11-13 (AMC) A10-11 (GND)
GR - W-B
Air mix damper servomotor operation signal
Ignition switch: ON
Set temperature:
MAX. WARM → MAX. COOL
Below 1.0 → 10 to 14 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1313
05-1 124
DIAGNOSTICS
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Terminal No. (Symbols)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
A11-14 (AMH) A10-11 (GND)
B - W-B
Air mix damper servomotor operation signal
Ignition switch: ON
Set temperature: MAX. COOL →
MAX. WARM
Below 1.0 → 10 to 14 V
Solar sensor signal
Ignition switch: ON
Solar sensor subject to electric light
→ Solar sensor is covered by a
cloth
4.5 to 5.5 →
Below 4.0 V
A11-16 (TS) - A11-15 (S5-3)
L-W
ECM
ECM Connector Wire Harness View:
E7
E8
E9
E6
E5
I30693
Terminal No. (Symbols)
E6-32 (TAM) - E7-28 (E2)
Wiring Color
B - BR
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
Ambient temperature signal
Ignition switch: ON
Ambient temperature:
40C (104F) → 25C (77F)
0.8 to 1.2 →
1.4 to 1.8 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1314
05-1879
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
05IPW-01
DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST
DATA LIST
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the hand-held tester, you can read the value of the switch, sensor,
actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of troubleshooting is one
method to shorten work time.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
(c) Connect the hand-held tester to DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
(e) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select ”DATA LIST”.
METER:
Item
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Normal Condition
SPEED METER
Vehicle speed / Min.: 0 km/h (0
mph), Max.: 255 km/h (158 mph)
TACHO METER
Engine speed / Min.: 50 rpm, Max.: Almost same as actual engine
12,750 rpm
speed (When engine is running)
Diagnostic Note
Almost same as actual vehicle
speed (When driving)
-
Fuel input signal
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
Fuel gauge indicates (F): 48
Fuel gauge indicates (3/4): 93
Fuel gauge indicates (1/2): 148
Fuel gauge indicates (1/4): 188
Fuel gauge indicates (E): 206
-
LIGHT RHEOSTAT
Light control rheostat / Min.: 0,
Max.: 255
Light control rheostat switch is
Dark (0) → Bright (255)
-
ODO/TRIP SW
ODO/TRIP switch is ON / OFF
ON: Switch is pushed
OFF: Switch is released
-
TAIL CANCEL SW
TAIL CANCEL switch is ON / OFF
ON: Tail cancel position
OFF: Except tail cancel position
-
Item
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
FUEL GAUGE
ECM:
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
VEHICLE SPEED
Vehicle speed / Min.: 0 km/h (0
mph), Max.: 255 km/h (158 mph)
Almost same as actual vehicle
speed (When driving)
-
ENGINE SPD
Engine speed / Min.: 0 rpm, Max.:
16,383 rpm
Almost same as actual engine
speed (When engine is running)
-
COOLANT TEMP
Coolant Temperature / Min.: -40C After warming up: 80 to 95°C (176
(-40 °F), Max.: 140C (284°F)
to 203°F)
If the value is ”-40C (-40°F)” or
”140C (284°F)”, sensor circuit is
open or shorted.
ABS:
Item
(FR/FL/RR/RL) SPD
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Vehicle speed / Min.: 0 km/h (0
mph), Max.: 326 km/h (202 mph)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Almost same as actual speed
(When driving)
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2069
05-1880
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
ACTIVE TEST
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the meters, indicators and so on to operate
without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one way to shorten
labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST on hand-held tester during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) From the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
METER:
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SPEED METER
0 / 40(25) / 80(50) / 120(75) / 160(99) / 200(124)
km/h(mph)
-
TACHOMETER
0rpm / 1000rpm / 2000rpm / 3000rpm / 4000rpm /
5000rpm / 6000rpm / 7000rpm
-
FUEL GAUGE
OFF, METER F, 3/4, 1/2, 1/4, METER E, EMPTY
-
COOLANT TEMP
LOW, 60C, 70C, 80C, NORMAL, 110C,
120C, HIGH
-
SHIFT INDIC
A/T indicator operation (P, R, N, D, S, 3, 2, L)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
LOW FUEL WARN
Indicat. Lamp FUEL (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
D-BEL T REMIND
Indicat. Lamp D-SEAT BELT (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Indicat. Lamp OIL (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Indicat. Lamp CHARGE (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Indicat. Lamp TAIL (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
CRUISE INDIC
Indicat. Lamp CRUISE (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Rr FOG INDIC
Indicat. Lamp Rr FOG (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
SRS WARN
Indicat. Lamp AIRBAG (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Indicat. Lamp TRAC (TRC) OFF (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Indicat. Lamp SLIP (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
O/D OFF INDIC
Indicat. Lamp O/D OFF (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
ODO/TRIP DISP
Indicat. ODO/TRIP DISPLAY (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
A/T OIL TEMP
A/T OIL temperatue operation (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Fr FOG INDIC
Indicat. Lamp Fr FOG (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Indicat. Lamp TIRE PRESS (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Indicat. Lamp DOOR (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Indicat. Lamp ECT SNOW (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Key remained buzzer (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
OIL PRESS WARN
DISCHARGE WARN
TAILLIGHT INDIC
TRC OFF INDIC
SLIP INDIC
TIRE PRESS WARN
DOOR WARN
ECT SNOW WARN
KEY REMND BUZZR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2070
05-1881
DIAGNOSTICS
Item
-
COMBINATION METER
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SEAT BELT BUZZR
Seat Belt buzzer (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
REVERSE BUZZER
Reverse buzzer (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
S SHFT RJCT BUZ
Sports Shift reject buzzer (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Speed buzzer (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Warning buzzer (OFF/ON)
Comfirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
SPEED BUZZER
WARNING BUZZER
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2071
05-1898
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
05IQ1-02
SEAT BELT WARNING LAMP FOR DRIVER’S SEAT DOES NOT
OPERATE
WIRING DIAGRAM
C12
Combination Meter Assy
Airbag Sensor Assembly
9
MPX+
BEAN
B19
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy (Driver’s Side)
6
2
LBE- A16 A16
(*2) (*1)
19 11
LBE+ A16 A16
(*2) (*1)
R
3
G
1
*1: w/o Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
I40146
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If there is an open in the ground circuit (Airbag sensor assy center), the airbag sensor assy center outputs
DTCs. Perform troubleshooting with the ”Supplemental Restraint System 05-1200 ”.
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
METER:
Item
D-BEL T REMIND
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
Confirm that the vehicle is stopped and engine
idling
Indicat. Lamp D-SEAT BELT (OFF/ON)
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2088
05-1899
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
COMBINATION METER
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER(DRIVER SEAT BELT)
(a) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select the ”DATA LIST”.
SRS AIRBAG:
Item
D SEAT BUCKL
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Driver seat belt buckle switch is
ON / OFF
NG
Diagnostic Note
ON: Seat belt is fastened
OFF: Seat belt is unfastened
-
Go to step 3
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
3
INSPECT FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY (DRIVER SIDE)
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy (Driver Side)
Connector Front View:
B4
I40135
(a)
Disconnect the connector from the front seat inner belt
assy (Driver Side).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Terminal No
Condition
Specified condition
B4-2 - B4-5
Seat belt is fastened
Approx. 330 Ω
B4-2 - B4-5
Seat belt is unfastened
Approx. 1,330 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY
(DRIVER SIDE)
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY - BODY
GROUND)(SEE PAGE 01-26 )
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy (Driver Side)
Wire Harness View:
B4
(a)
Disconnect the connector from the front seat inner belt
assy (Driver Side).
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B4-5 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Go to step 5
E58133
OK
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2089
05-1900
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
COMBINATION METER
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY - AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSY CENTER)(SEE PAGE 01-26 )
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy (Driver Side)
Wire Harness View:
B4
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the B4, A23 connectors.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B4-2 - A23-10
Always
Below 1 Ω
A23-10 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
Wire Harness View:
A23
NG
I39225
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2090
05-1883
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
05IPX-02
ENTIRE COMBINATION METER DOES NOT OPERATE
WIRING DIAGRAM
4
4M
W
Combination Meter Assy
J6
J/C
Passenger Side J/B
1
4E
P
9
IL1
P
E
E
SB
13
C11
P
1
C11
Center J/B
I15
Ignition SW
Instrument Panel J/B
13
1K
BR
HEATER
IGN
6
1G
10
1G
7
3C
4
3A
B
7
1C
W
G
1
1C
1
1K
4 IG1
AM1 2
6 IG2
AM2 7
Y
GR
5
IC3
F7
FL Block
AM2
1
2I
D.C.C
ALT
B
2
ECU-B
4
2A
1
IC1
L-Y
10
1
W-L
Engine Room J/B
W
3
W
2
C11
LG
Instrument Panel J/B
6
1
AM1
1C
1A
1
2
Center J/B
BR
2
3K
12
3B
R
11
C11
FL MAIN
Battery
IB
I40141
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2073
05-1884
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSY
(a)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Wire Harness View:
C11-2
C11-1
Terminal No
Condition
Specified condition
C11-1 1 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
(b)
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
C11-1 1
C11-13
I40698
Terminal No
Condition
Specified condition
C11-2 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
C11-1 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
C11-13 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2074
05-1885
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
05IPY-02
MALFUNCTION IN SPEEDOMETER
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
With Actuator
SP1
12
S27
Combination Meter Assy
15
IC4
BR-R
18
IF3
BR
GR
6
C12
I40142
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
METER:
Item
SPEED METER
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
0 / 40(24) / 80(48) / 120(72) / 160(96) / 200(120)
km/h(mph)
-
OK:
Needle indication is normal.
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2075
05-1886
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
COMBINATION METER
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER(VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL)
(a) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select the ”DATA LIST”.
METER:
Item
SPEED METER
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Vehicle speed / Min.: 1 km/h (1
mph), Max.: 255 km/h (158 mph)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Almost same as actual vehicle
speed (When driving)
-
OK:
Vehicle speed displayed on the tester is almost the same as the actual vehicle speed.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
3
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER(VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL)
(a) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select the ”DATA LIST”.
ABS:
Item
(FR/FL/RR/RL) SPD
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Vehicle speed / Min.: 0 km/h (0
mph), Max.: 326 km/h (202 mph)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Almost same as actual speed
(When driving)
-
OK:
Vehicle speed displayed on the tester is almost the same as the actual vehicle speed.
NG
GO TO BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
(SEE PAGE 05-761 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2076
05-1887
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
COMBINATION METER
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSY
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
(a) Check the input signal waveform.
(1) Remove the combination meter assy.
(2) Connect the oscilloscope to the terminals C12-6
and body ground.
(3) Start the engine.
Wire Harness View:
C12-6
I30440
(4)
Check the signal waveform according to the condition (s) in the table below.
Item
Condition
Tool setting
5 V/DIV, 20 ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Driving at approx. 20 Km/h (12 mph)
OK:
As shown in the illustration
A05135
HINT:
As vehicle speed increases, the cycle of the signal waveform
narrows.
NG
Go to step 5
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2077
05-1888
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
COMBINATION METER
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(ABS&TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY(VSC) COMBINATION METER ASSY)(SEE PAGE 01-26 )
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the C12 and S27 connectors.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
ABS&Traction Actuator Assy (VSC)
Wire Harness View:
S27-12
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
C12-6 - S27-12
Always
Below 1 Ω
C12-6 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE
Combination Meter Assy
Wire Harness View:
C12-6
I40607
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
HARNESS
AND
OK
6
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSY
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the S27 connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
ABS&Traction Actuator Assy (VSC)
Wire Harness View:
S27-12
I40133
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S27-12 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
OK
GO TO BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM(SEE PAGE 05-761 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2078
05-1893
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
0524B-04
MALFUNCTION IN FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assy
J13
J/C
P
A
F12
FUEL SENDER
(FUEL PUMP
AND SENDER)
P
5
BH1
O
2
IR2
O
O
14
BH1
Y
11
IR2
V
A
9
C11
2
3
O
D
D
Center J/B
6
3B
2
3K
BR
IB
I40596
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
METER:
Item
FUEL GAUGE
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
OFF, EMPTY, 1/2, FULL
-
OK: Needle indication is normal.
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2083
05-1894
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
COMBINATION METER
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER(FUEL GAUGE)
(a) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select the ”DATA LIST”.
METER:
Item
FUEL GAUGE
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Fuel gauge indicates (F): 48
Fuel gauge indicates (3/4): 93
Fuel gauge indicates (1/2): 148
Fuel gauge indicates (1/4): 188
Fuel gauge indicates (E): 206
Fuel input signal
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
OK:
Fuel input signal displayed on the tester is almost the same as Needle indication.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
3
INSPECT FUEL SENDER GAUGE ASSY
(a)
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Fuel Sender Gauge
Connector Front View:
I30899
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
F20-1 - F20-3
Ignition switch ACC or ON
Below 1 to 5 V
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Remove the fuel sender gauge assy.
Connect the fuel sender gauge connector.
Check that the float position is between E and F.
Measure the voltage between the terminals 2 and 1 of
connector according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
F
Warning
Float level
Float position mm (in.)
Voltage (V)
F
-34.8 (-1.37) 3 (0.12)
4.5 to 4.75
1/2
92.8 (3.65) 3 (0.12)
1.41 1.61
Warning
137.0 (5.39) 3 (0.12)
0.20 to 0.45
E
I39224
NG
REPLACE FUEL SENDER GAUGE ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2084
05-1895
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
COMBINATION METER
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(FUEL SENDER GAUGE ASSY COMBINATION METER ASSY)(SEE PAGE 01-26 )
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the F12 and C11 connectors.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Combination Meter Assy
Wire Harness View:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
C11-9 - F12-2
Always
F12-3 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
F11-9 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
C11-9
Fuel Sender Gauge Connector
Front View:
F12
NG
I40609
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2085
05-1869
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
05246-04
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
COMBINATION METER SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
VIN
Customer’s Name
Production Date
Licence Plate No.
Date of Vehicle
Brought In
/
/
Odometer Reading
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Frequency Problem Occurs
Weather Conditions
When Problem
Occurred
Weather
km
mile
/
Constantly Sometimes (
Times per day, month)
Once only
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Snowy
Various/Others
Warm
Outside Temperature Hot
Cold (Approx.
Cool
°F ( °C))
Gauge
Malfunction in speedometer
Malfunction in tachometer
Malfunction in water temperature receiver gauge
Malfunction in fuel receiver gauge
Entire combination meter does not operate
Others
Problem Symptom
Seat belt warning lamp for driver’s seat does not operate
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2059
05-1868
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
COMBINATION METER
05245-04
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS (SEE PAGE 05-1869 )
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION (SEE PAGE 05-1882 )
4
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 05-2095 )
(a)
Check for DTC outputs.
MULTIPLEX DTC OUTPUTS (PROCEED TO
”BODY MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM”)
NO MULTIPLEX DTC (GO TO STEP 5)
5
(a)
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 05-2095 )
Check for DTC outputs.
CAN DTC OUTPUTS (PROCEED TO ”CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM”)
NO CAN DTC (GO TO STEP 6)
6
CIRCUIT INSPECTION (SEE PAGE 05-1883 - 05-1898 )
7
REPAIR OR REPLACE
8
CONFIRMATION TEST
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2058
05-1889
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
05IPZ-02
MALFUNCTION IN TACHOMETER
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assy
ECM
Passenger Side J/B
TACH
5
E5
B
5
4F
11
4L
GR
21
IL2
O
1
C12
I40143
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
METER:
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
TACHOMETER
0rpm / 1000rpm / 2000rpm / 3000rpm / 4000rpm /
5000rpm / 6000rpm / 7000rpm
-
OK:
Needle indication is normal.
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
OK
Author:
Date:
2079
05-1890
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
COMBINATION METER
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER(ENGINE SPEED SIGNAL)
(a) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select the ”DATA LIST”.
METER:
Item
TACHO METER
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Engine speed / Min.: 50 rpm, Max.: Almost same as actual engine
12,750 rpm
speed (When engine is running)
-
OK:
Engine speed displayed on the tester is almost the same as the actual engine speed.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
3
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER(ENGINE SPEED SIGNAL)
(a) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select the ”DATA LIST”.
ALL (ECM):
Item
ENGINE SPD
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Engine speed / Min.: 50 rpm, Max.: Almost same as actual engine
12,750 rpm
speed (When engine is running)
-
OK:
Engine speed displayed on the tester is almost the same as the actual engine speed.
NG
GO TO ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
(SEE PAGE 05-5 , 05-362 )
OK
Author:
Date:
2080
05-1891
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
COMBINATION METER
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSY
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
(a) Check the input signal waveform.
(1) Remove the combination meter assy.
(2) Connect the oscilloscope to the terminals C12-1
and body ground.
(3) Start the engine.
Wire Harness View:
C12-1
I30440
(4)
Check the signal waveform according to the condition (s) in the table below.
Item
Condition
Tool setting
5 V/DIV, 10 ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
OK:
As shown in the illustration
A05138
NG
Go to step 5
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
Author:
Date:
2081
05-1892
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
COMBINATION METER
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(ECM - COMBINATION METER ASSY)
(SEE PAGE 01-26 )
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the C12 and E5 connectors.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
ECM Wire Harness View:
E5-5
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
C12-1 - E5-5
Always
Below 1 Ω
C12-1 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE
Combination Meter Assy
Wire Harness View:
C12-1
I40608
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
HARNESS
AND
OK
6
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSY
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the E5 connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
ECM Wire Harness View:
E5-5
I40144
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E5-5 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
OK
GO TO ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM(SEE PAGE 05-5 , 05-366 )
Author:
Date:
2082
05-1896
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
05IQ0-05
MALFUNCTION IN WATER TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE
WIRING DIAGRAM
C11
Combination Meter Assy
ECM
21
BEAN
E2
28
E7
Short Connector
5
5
BR
S29
S28
BR
BR*1
1
W-B*2
THW
19
E7
MPX-
G-B
E2
Engine
Coolant
2 Temp Sensor
*1: 2AZ-FE
*2: 3MZ-FE
I44266
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If there is an open or short in the engine coolant temperature sensor circuit, the ECM outputs DTCs. Perform
troubleshooting with the ”SFI System 05-5 ,.05-366 ”.
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
METER:
Item
COOLANT TEMP
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
LOW / NORMAL / HI
-
OK:
Needle indication is normal.
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
OK
Author:
Date:
2086
05-1897
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
COMBINATION METER
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER(ENGINE COOLANT)
(a) Operate the hand-held tester according to the steps on the display and select the ”DATA LIST”.
ECM:
Item
COOLANT TEMP
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Coolant Temperature / Min.: -40C After warming up: 80 to 95°C (176
(-40 °F), Max.: 140C (284°F)
to 203°F)
Diagnostic Note
If the value is ”-40C (-40°F)” or
”140C (284°F)”, sensor circuit is
open or shorted.
OK:
Coolant temperature displayed on the tester is between 80C (176F) and 95C (203F) after
warning up.
NG
GO TO ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
(SEE PAGE 05-5 , 05-366 )
OK
3
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY
OK:
Normal operation
NG
GO TO ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
(SEE PAGE 05-5 , 05-366 )
OK
END
Author:
Date:
2087
05-1870
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
05IPU-01
LOCATION
Fuel Sender Gauge
Brake Fluid Warning Switch
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
Rear Door Courtesy
Switch
Front Door Courtesy Switch
Engine Room J/B
DOME Fuse
ECU-B Fuse
Washer Level Warning Switch
I40697
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2060
05-1871
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
Passenger Seat Belt Warning
ECM
Body ECU
Center J/B
Combination Meter
Passenger Side J/B
Occupant Detection
ECU
Instrument Panel J/B
IGN Fuse
Buckle Switch
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
I40158
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2061
05-1872
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
2AZ-FE Engine:
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Oil Pressure Switch
3MZ-FE Engine:
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Oil Pressure Switch
I30455
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2062
05-1873
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
C12
C11
I30438
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2063
05-1874
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
C12-1 (TACHO)
C11-1 1 (SIGNAL GND)
C11-7 (ILL)
Light Control
Rheostat SW
ODO/TRIP SW
LCD
C12-6 (SI)
SPEED
TACHO
FUEL
C12-13 (4P OUT)
CPU
TEMP
C11-9 (FUEL)
C11-13 (IG2)
C11-1 (IG+)
C11-2 (ECU+B)
C11-12 (DOME)
C11-22 (POWER GND)
BUZZER
CPU
DOOR
I40058
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2064
05-1875
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
P
R
N
D
3
2
L
CPU
S
FUEL
O/D OFF
ECT SNOW
CHARGE
OIL PRESSER
CRUISE
SEAT BELT
AIRBAG
SLIP
TRC/TRAC OFF
A/T OIL TEMP
OIL MAINT
TIRE AIR PRESS
OIL LEVEL
TURN L
C11-14 (TURN L)
TURN R
C11-15 (TURN R)
BEAM
C11-19 (BEAM-)
WASHER LEVEL
C12-12 (WASHER LEVEL)
C12-16 (BEAM+)
CHECK ENGINE
C12-4 (CHECK ENGINE)
C12-10 (BRAKE LEVEL)
C12-11 (BRAKE)
C11-17 (ABS)
ACTIVE
CIRCUIT
C12-7 (VSC)
BRAKE
ABS
VSC
C12-9 (MPX+)
CPU
C11-21 (MPX-)
I40059
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2065
05-1876
DIAGNOSTICS
Terminal No.
C11
1
C12
-
COMBINATION METER
Wire Harness Side
HEATER Fuse
2
ECU-B Fuse
7
PANEL Fuse
9
Fuel sender gauge
11
Ground (Signal Ground)
12
DOME Fuse
13
IGN Fuse
14
Turn Signal Flasher
15
Turn Signal Flasher
17
Skid Control ECU
19
Headlight Dimmer Switch
21
Multiplex Communication Line (MPX-)
22
Ground (Power Ground)
1
ECM
4
ECM
6
Skid Control ECU (SI)
7
Skid Control ECU (VSC)
9
Multiplex Communication Line (MPX+)
10
Brake Warning Switch
11
Skid Control ECU
12
Washer Level Warning Switch
13
Speed Control Unit (4P-OUT)
16
Headlight Relay
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2066
05-1882
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
05248-04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Chart No.
Symptom
See page
1
Entire combination meter does not operate
05-1883
2
Malfunction in speedometer
05-1885
3
Malfunction in tachometer
05-1889
4
Malfunction in fuel receiver gauge
05-1893
5
Malfunction in water temperature receiver gauge
05-1896
7
Seat belt warning lamp for driver’s seat does not operate
05-1898
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2072
05-1877
DIAGNOSTICS
-
COMBINATION METER
05IPV-03
TERMINALS OF ECU
COMBINATION METER ASSY
C12
C11
I30439
Symbols (Terminals No.)
IG+ (C11-1) - Body ground
ECU+B (C11-2) - Body ground
Wiring Color
P - Body ground
LG - Body
ground
Terminal Description
Condition
Ignition switch signal
Ignition switch OFF → ON
Battery
Always
Specified Condition
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
10 to 14 V
ILL (C11-7) - Body ground
B - Body ground
Illumination signal
Tail light OFF → ON
FUEL (C11-9) - Body ground
O - Body ground
Fuel signal
Ignition switch ON, fuel level is
FULL → EMPTY
SIGNAL GND (C11-1 1) Body ground
R - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
DOME (C11-12) - Body ground
V - Body ground
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
Ignition switch signal
Ignition switch OFF → ON
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
IG2 (C11-13) - Body ground
SB - Body
ground
Pulse generation
Below 1 V →
4 to 7 V
TURN L (C11-14) Body ground
L - Body ground
Turn signal L
Ignition switch ON, turn signal LH
indicator OFF → ON
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
TURN R (C11-15) Body ground
GR - Body
ground
Turn signal R
Ignition switch ON, turn signal RH
indicator OFF → ON
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
ABS signal
Ignition switch ON, ABS warning
light ON → OFF
6.7 to 12 V →
Below 1 V
Hi-Beam signal
Headlight dimmer switch Lo → Hi
10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
Communication signal
Communication circuit
Ground
Always
ABS (C11-17) - Body ground
BEAM- (C11-19) Body ground
MPX- (C11-21)
POWER GND (C11-22) Body ground
W - Body ground
BR - Body
ground
W-B - Body
ground
Below 1 Ω
Pulse generation
(See waveform 2)
TACH (C12-1) - Body ground
O - Body ground
Tacho meter signal (Input)
Engine running
CHECK ENGINE (C12-4) Body ground
L - Body ground
CHECK ENGINE signal
Ignition switch ON, CHECK ENGINE warning light ON → OFF
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
SP1 (C12-6) - Body ground
GR - Body
ground
Speed signal (Input)
Ignition switch ON and turn the
wheel slowly
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
VSC (C12-7) - Body ground
P - Body ground
VSC signal
Ignition switch ON, VSC warning
light ON → OFF
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2067
05-1878
DIAGNOSTICS
MPX+ (C12-9)
-
COMBINATION METER
-
Communication signal
Communication circuit
BRAKE (C12-10) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Brake fluid level signal
Ignition switch ON, brake fluid level
(LO) → NORMAL
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
BRAKE (C12-11) Body ground
B - Body ground
Brake signal
Ignition switch ON, BRAKE warning
light ON → OFF
6.7 to 12 V →
Below 1 V
Washer level signal
Washer indicator OFF → ON
10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
WASHER LEVEL (C12-12) Body ground
BR - Body
ground
-
4P OUT (C12-13) Body ground
W - Body ground
Speed signal (Output)
Ignition switch ON and turn the
wheel slowly
BEAM+ (C12-16) Body ground
G - Body ground
Hi-Beam signal
Hi-Beam OFF → ON
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
Waveform 1 (Reference):
Item
Contents
Tool setting
5 V/DIV, 20 ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Driving at approx. 20 Km/h
HINT:
As the vehicle speed increases, the cycle of the signal waveform narrows.
A05135
Waveform 2 (Reference):
Item
Contents
Tool setting
5 V/DIV, 10 ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
A05138
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2068
05-1981
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
05JFT-02
SLIDING ROOF DOES NOT MOVE BY SLIDING ROOF CONTROL
SWITCH
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The sliding roof drive gear sub-assy (sliding roof ECU) monitors a sliding roof motor switch signal in line,
and the motor built in the sliding roof drive gear sub-assy (sliding roof ECU) is driven.
WIRING DIAGRAM
S20
Sliding Roof Control ECU
J17
J/C
P
3
IE1
2
IE1
P
E
E
W
AM1
IG1
2
Instrument
Panel J/B
9 1D 8 1H
L
1
G
UP
2
S/ROOF
5
I15
O5
Ignition SW
Over Head J/B
4
G
7 1C
W
6 1C
B
6
W
DWN
AM1
8
4
IG1
9
1
R
IG3
1 1A
10 1G
11
2 1D
BR
W-B
7
GR
Engine
W-L
Room J/B
4 2A
9
W-B
IG
B
W-B
IG
10
E
MPX1
6 IE1
E6
ECM
5 4D
6 4M 7 4L
2
ALT
1 W
FL Main
Y
Passenger Side J/B
D.C.C
F7
FL Block
DWN
8 IE1
ECU-B
1 2I
3 W
UP
1
4 IE1
5 IC3
B
W-B
GND
V
6
ECUB
Instrument
Panel J/B
W-B
4 1E
1 4N
GR
MPX2
29
GR
1 IL2
W-B
W-B
14
1D
SB
C12
Combination
Meter
W-B
Battery
IA
IC
9
MPX+
B80388
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2171
05-1982
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Enter into the DATA LIST of the hand-held tester.
Sliding Roof ECU
Item
Switch condition
Standard value
OPEN SW
Pressed → Unpressed
ON/OFF
CLOSE SW
Pressed → Unpressed
ON/OFF
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Enter into the ACTIVE TEST of the hand-held tester.
Sliding Roof ECU
Item
Condition
Sliding Roof
CLOSE/UP
Sliding Roof
OPEN/DOWN
NG
Go to step 6
OK
3
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Enter into the DATA LIST of the hand-held tester.
Sliding Roof ECU
Item
Switch condition
Standard value
Hall IC condition
Do sliding and tiling operation
ON/OFF
OK
REPLACE SLIDING
SUB-ASSY
ROOF
DRIVE
GEAR
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2172
05-1983
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
S20
Sliding Roof Control ECU
B
ECUB
Symbol (Terminal No.)
Condition
E (S20-7) ⇔ Body ground
Constant
Continuity
B (S20-1) ⇔ E (S20-7)
Constant
10 to 14 V
ECUB (S20-5) ⇔ E
(S20-7)
Constant
10 to 14 V
E
B80389
(c)
(d)
Wire Harness Side
O5
Overhead J/B
Disconnect the S20 roof drive gear connector.
Check the voltage or continuity between the terminals of
the S20 roof drive gear wire harness side connector.
Standard:
Disconnect the O5 overhead J/B connector.
Check the voltage or continuity between the terminals of
the O5 overhead J/B wire harness side connector.
Standard:
Symbol (Terminal No.)
GND
IG (O5-9) ⇔ GND (O5-1)
condition
Specified condition
Ignition switch position
OFF → ON
0V → 10V - 14V
Constant
Continuity
GND (O5-1) ⇔ Body ground
IG
Specified condition
B80390
(e)
(f)
Wire Harness Side
S20
Sliding Roof Control ECU
UP
Disconnect the O5 overhead J/B connector.
Check the continuity between the S20 drive gear and O5
overhead J/B wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Symbol (Terminal No.)
(Drive gear ⇔ Motor switch)
Specified condition
UP (S20-8) ⇔ UP (O5-6)
Continuity
DWN (S20-9) ⇔ DOWN (O5-4)
Continuity
IG (S20-6) ⇔ IG3 (O5-11)
Continuity
DWN
O5
OVERHEAD J/B
DOWN
UP
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
B70473
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2173
05-1984
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
INSPECT SLIDE ROOF MOTOR SWITCH
(a)
O5
OVERHEAD J/B
Inspect the overhead J/B continuity.
Standard:
Terminal No.
Condition
Specified condition
1⇔8
Slide open
Continuity
1⇔9
Tilt up
Continuity
B78737
6
(a)
NG
REPLACE SLIDE ROOF MOTOR SWITCH
OK
REPLACE SLIDING
SUB-ASSY
ROOF
DRIVE
GEAR
CHECK MOVEMENT OF SLIDING ROOF
Remove the sliding roof drive gear, then check that the sliding roof can be moved by hand.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE SLIDING ROOF
OK
REPLACE SLIDING ROOF DRIVE GEAR SUB-ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2174
05-1975
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
051RB-03
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
SLIDING ROOF CONTROL SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
Registration No.
Registration Year
Customer’s Name
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought in
/
/
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Frequency Problem Occurs
Weather Conditions
When Problem
Occurred
km
miles
Odometer Reading
Constant
Once only
Sometimes (
/
Times per day, month)
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Various/Others
Hot
Warm
Cool
Outdoor temperature
Cold (Approx.
°C ( °F))
Weather
Snowy
Problem Symptom
Sliding roof control system does not operate.
Sliding roof operates abnormally or stops halfway.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2165
05-1974
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
051RA-04
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS (See page 05-1975 )
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
(a)
(b)
If the symptom does not occur, proceed to A.
If the symptom occurs, proceed to B.
A
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
B
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (See page 05-1980 )
5
CIRCUIT INSPECTION (See page 05-1981 )
6
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
7
REPAIR OR REPLACE
8
CONFIRMATION TEST
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2164
05-1977
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
051RC-04
LOCATION
Sliding Roof Housing
Sliding Roof Drive Gear
Sub-assy (Sliding Roof ECU)
Slide Roof Motor Switch
B51423
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2167
05-1976
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
0523P-03
PRE-CHECK
1.
CHECK USING HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Select the DATA LIST mode on the hand-held tester.
Sliding Roof ECU
Item
Switch condition
Standard value
OPEN SW
Pressed→Unpressed
ON/OFF
CLOSE SW
Pressed→Unpressed
ON/OFF
Position detection SW 1
Do sliding and tilting operation
ON/OFF
Position detection SW 2
Do sliding and tilting operation
ON/OFF
Hall IC condition
Do sliding and tiling operation
Normal/Abnormal
Hall IC out put
Do sliding and tiling operation
Lo/Hi
IG
Ignition Switch ON→OFF
ON/OFF
IG line signal
Ignition Switch ON→OFF
ON/OFF
Operation possible after key-OFF
Ignition Switch ON→OFF
ON/OFF
(c) The active test will indicate if the part is normal or malfunctioning.
Sliding Roof ECU
Item
Condition
Sliding Roof
CLOSE/UP
Sliding Roof
OPEN/DOWN
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2166
05-1980
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
051RE-04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspected Area
See page
Sliding roof system operates abnormally.
1. Slide roof control switch
2. Sliding roof control motor and relay
3. Wire harness
05-1981
05-1981
-
Sliding roof system stops operation halfway.
(No foreign materials are trapped in motor assembly)
1. Slide roof control switch
2. Sliding roof control motor and relay
3. Wire harness
05-1981
05-1981
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2170
05-1978
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
05JFS-03
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
S20
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF DRIVE GEAR SUB-ASSY
(SLIDING ROOF ECU)
B31361
(a)
Disconnect the sliding roof ECU connector, and check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the
wire harness side connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring color
ECUB (S20-5) ⇔
Body ground
Condition
Specified condition
B⇔ -
Constant
10 to 14 V
B (S20-1) ⇔
Body ground
L⇔ -
Constant
10 to 14 V
E (S20-7) ⇔
Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Continuity
If the result is not as specified, there may be a malfunction on the wire harness.
2.
CHECK OVERHEAD J/B
O5
B78737
(a)
Disconnect the overhead J/B connector, and check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the
connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring color
UP (O5-6) ⇔
Body ground
Condition
Specified condition
G⇔-
Each switch OFF
Continuity
DOWN (O5-4) ⇔
Body ground
W⇔-
Each switch OFF
Continuity
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2168
05-1979
DIAGNOSTICS
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring color
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
Condition
Specified condition
G⇔-
Ignition switch ON
Sliding roof fully closed
Slide open switch OFF → ON
(Slide open side)
0 V → 10 to 14 V
DOWN (O5-4) ⇔
Body ground
W⇔-
Ignition switch ON
Sliding roof fully opened
Tilt up switch OFF → ON
(Slide close side)
0 V → 10 to 14 V
IG (O5-9) ⇔
Body ground
GR ⇔ -
Ignition switch ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V
GND (O5-1) ⇔
Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Continuity
UP (O5-6) ⇔
Body ground
If the result is not as specified, there may be a malfunction on the wire harness.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2169
05-2036
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
05ITO-02
BACK DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The back door key lock and unlock switch comes on when the back door key cylinder is turned to the unlock
side with the key.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Warning ECU Assy
B14
Back Door Key Lock
and Unlock Switch
LOCK
BR
9
BG3
V
14
IA2
Y
17
IL2
SB
15
T4 L
Y
4
BG2
B
4
IA2
LG
8
IL2
BR
33
T4 UL
2
1
W-B
UNLOCK
3
A
J14
J/C
BE
B51271
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BACK DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
(a)
(b)
Remove the switch.
Measure the resistance.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
1-2
Turned to lock side
Below 1 Ω
1-2, 1-3
Not turned
10 kΩ or higher
1-3
Turned to unlock side
Below 1 Ω
LOCK
UNLOCK
Specified Condition
I07296
NG
REPLACE BACK DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SWITCH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2226
05-2037
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY - BACK DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
B14
Back Door Key
Lock and Unlock Switch
Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
Disconnect the B14 switch connector.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B14-2 (LOCK) - T4-15 (L)
Below 1 Ω
B14-8 (UNLOCK) - T4-33 (UL)
Below 1 Ω
T4
Theft Warning ECU Assy
B77251
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
CHECK BACK DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH (BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
B14
Back Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
(a)
(b)
B31046
Disconnect the B14 switch connector.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connector and body ground.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B14-1 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2227
05-2026
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
0522S-06
ECU POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to operate the theft deterrent (warning) ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
5
IC3
BR
1G
10
T4 Theft Warning ECU Assy
J17
J/C
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
P
P
1D
9
L
W-L
E
E
4
IC3
W
11
O 2
IL1
2
IF1
L
3
+B1
+B2
Engine Room
J/B Assy
4 2A
2A
5
ECU-B
SECURITY
D.C.C
W-B
1
2I
29
E
3 W
F7
FUSIBLE
LINK BLOCK
1
Center J/B
3D 5
W
FL Main
Battery
3F 13
W-B
IB
B80399
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2216
05-2027
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
CHECK THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY (ECU-B)
Remove the ECU-B fuse from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
T4
Theft Warning ECU Assy
B63408
Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-2 (+B1) - T4-29 (E)
10 to 14 V
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
CHECK THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY (GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
T4
Theft Warning ECU Assy
Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connector and body ground.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-2 (+B1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
T4-29 (E) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
B63408
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2217
05-2038
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
05ITP-01
ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The hood door courtesy switch is built in the engine hood lock assembly. The switch comes on when the
engine hood is opened and goes off when the engine hood is closed.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Warning ECU Assy
E3
Security Courtesy Switch
(Engine Hood Courtesy Switch)
W-B
2
A
15
IK3
G-B
1
6
IL2
G
34
T4 DSWH
W
J1
J/C
EG
B51273
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT SECURITY COURTESY SWITCH
Not Pushed (ON)
Security
Courtesy Switch
(a)
(b)
Remove the courtesy switch.
Measure the resistance of the switch.
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Pushed (OFF (Lock))
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Not pushed (ON (Unlock))
Below 1 Ω
Pushed
(OFF)
I04148
NG
REPLACE SECURITY COURTESY SWITCH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2228
05-2039
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY - SECURITY COURTESY SWITCH
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
E3
Security Courtesy Switch
Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
Disconnect the E3 switch connector.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-34 (DSWH) - E3-1
Below 1 Ω
T4
Theft Warning ECU Assy
NG
B77252
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(SECURITY COURTESY SWITCH - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
E3
Security Courtesy Switch
Disconnect the E3 switch connector.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connector and body ground.
Standard:
NG
B31016
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E3-2 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2229
05-2031
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
0522U-05
IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, battery positive voltage is applied to terminal IG of the
ECU. When battery positive voltage is applied to terminal IG of the ECU while the theft deterrent system is
operating, the warning stops. Furthermore, the power supplied from terminal IG of the ECU is used as the
power for the door courtesy switch and position switch, etc.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center J/B
G
2
AM1
IG1
W
4
Theft Warning ECU Assy
Instrument Panel J/B
I15
Ignition Switch
7
1C
ECU-IG
6
AM1
1C
9
1K
R
10
G
T4
IG
1
B
1A
2
5
3E
1
3A
1
F7
FL Block
FL Main
W
1
2
Battery
B51270
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2221
05-2032
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK ECU-IG FUSE (ECU-IG)
(a)
(b)
ECU-IG Fuse
B51577
Remove the ECU-IG fuse from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY (IG VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
T4
Theft warning ECU Assy
B63408
Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage between the wire harness side connector and body ground.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-10 (IG) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2222
05-2024
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
05ITK-02
INDICATOR LIGHT CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
While the theft deterrent system is preparing to be set, this circuit lights up the indicator lamp. When the system is set, it continuously turns the indicator lamp on for 0.75 seconds and then turns it off for 1.25 seconds,
thus the indicator lamp blinks.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Warning ECU Assy
Center J/B
W-B
B
1
2
11
3F
13
3F
2
3B
8
3C
R
25
T4
IND
T5
Security Indicator
Lamp Assy
W-B
IB
B65516
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SECURITY INDICATOR LAMP ASSY (OPERATION)
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the T5 indicator lamp connector.
Check if the security indicator lamp comes on when battery voltage is applied to each terminal of the connector.
1
Standard:
2
Measuring Condition
Specified Operation
Battery positive (+) - Terminal 2
Battery negative (-) - Terminal 1
Indicator lamp comes on.
B51710
NG
REPLACE SECURITY INDICATOR LAMP ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2214
05-2025
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY - SECURITY INDICATOR LAMP ASSY)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
Disconnect the T5 indicator lamp and T4 ECU connectors
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connecters.
Standard:
T5
Security Indicator
Lamp Assy
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-25 (IND) - T5-2
Below 1 Ω
T4
Theft Warning ECU Assy
NG
B77249
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SECURITY INDICATOR LAMP ASSY - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
T5
Theft Deterrent
Indicator Lamp Assy
B78292
Disconnect the T5 indicator lamp connector
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connector and body ground.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T5-1 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2215
05-2033
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
05ITN-03
UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The key unlock warning switch comes on when the ignition key is inserted in the ignition key cylinder and
goes off when the ignition key is removed.
The ECU operates the key confinement prevention function while the key unlock warning switch is on.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Warning ECU Assy
W-B
K4
Unlock Warning
J6
Switch
J/C
1
DG
2 G D
18
IL2
P
12
T4 KSW
D
Passenger Side J/B
9 4G
Body ECU
4N 1 4L 7
W-B
W-B
IC
B80391
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2223
05-2034
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY
(a)
(b)
Not Pushed
(ON)
Remove the warning switch.
Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard:
Pushed
(OFF)
2 1
4 3
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Not pushed
(ON (Key inserted))
Below 1 Ω
1-2
Pushed
(OFF (Key removed))
10 kΩ or higher
B51581
NG
REPLACE UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY - UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
K4
Unlock Warning Switch
Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
Disconnect the K4 switch connector.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-12 (KSW) - K4-2
Below 1 Ω
T4
Theft Warning ECU Assy
NG
B77247
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2224
05-2035
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY - BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
K4
Unlock
Warning Switch
B31124
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the K4 switch connector.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connector and body ground.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
(K4-1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2225
05-2028
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
05ITM-04
THEFT DETERRENT HORN CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the theft deterrent system is operating, the relay in the ECU turns on and off in a cycle of approximately
0.2 seconds, causing the theft warning horn to blow (see the wiring diagram below).
WIRING DIAGRAM
INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B ASSY
5
IC3
W - L
BR
1G
10
1D
9
E
4
IC3
2A 5
Theft Warning ECU Assy
11
O 2
IL1
P
P
L
4 2A
T4
J17
J/C
E
2
IF1
W
3
L
+B1
+B2
Engine Room J/B
ECU-B
SECURITY
D.C.C
2I
17
1
IF3 LG
B
1
SH-
3 W
F7
FUSIBLE
LINK BLOCK
1
IC3 2
W
B - O
FL MAIN
1
BATTERY
T1
Theft Deterrent
Horn
B80404
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
CHECK THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY (SECURITY)
Remove the SECURITY fuse from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2218
05-2029
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
CHECK THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY (THEFT WARNING ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
T4
Theft Warning ECU Assy
Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
Measure the voltage between the T4 ECU connector and
body ground.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-3 (+B2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
B63408
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
CHECK SECURITY HORN ASSY
(a)
(b)
1
B51580
B64984
Disconnect the T1 security horn connector.
Check operation of the security horn.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Body ground
Security horn blows
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2219
05-2030
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
CHECK SECURITY HORN ASSY (THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY - SECURITY HORN
ASSY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
T4
Theft Warning ECU Assy
Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
Disconnect the T1 security horn connector.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-1 (SH-) - T1-1
Below 1 Ω
T1
Security Horn Assy
1
NG
B63408
B58961
REPLACE SECURITY HORN ASSY
B64978
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2220
05-2013
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
0522N-03
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
VIN
Production Date
Customer’s Name
Licence Plate No.
Date Vehicle
Brought in
/
/
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Constant
Once only
Frequency Problem Occurs
Weather Conditions
When Problem
Occurred
km
miles
Odometer Reading
Sometimes (
/
Times per day, month)
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Various/Others
Hot
Warm
Cool
Outdoor temperature
Cold (Approx.
°C ( °F))
Weather
Snowy
Problem Symptom
Theft deterrent system cannot be set.
Indicator lamp does not flash when theft deterrent system is set.
(It stays on or does not illuminate at all.)
Theft deterrent system
does not operate.
When unlocked using
door lock knob.
When engine hood
is opened.
Theft deterrent system
cannot be canceled
once set.
When door is unlocked using key or wireless door lock control system.
When key is inserted into ignition key cylinder and turned to ACC or ON
(however, only when the system has never operated).
When back door is opened with key.
Theft deterrent system
cannot be canceled during
warning operation.
When door is unlocked using key or wireless door lock control system.
When key is inserted into ignition key cylinder and turned to ACC or ON.
Malfunction
Horns only
Warning only
Headlights only
Taillights only
Starter cut only
Door lock operation only
Warning operation does not start when system is set and door or back door is opened with key.
Other
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2203
05-2012
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
0522M-03
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Use this procedure to troubleshoot the theft deterrent system.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS AND SYMPTOM CHECK (See page 05-2013 )
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (See page 05-2023 )
(a)
(b)
If the fault is not listed on the problem symptoms table, proceed to A.
If the fault is listed on the problem symptoms table, proceed to B.
B
Go to step 5
A
4
(a)
(b)
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Pre-check (see page 05-2014 ).
Terminals of ECU (see page 05-2022 ).
5
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
6
CONFIRMATION TEST
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2202
05-2021
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
0522O-03
LOCATION
Theft Warning Horn Assy
Security Courtesy Switch
Security Indicator Lamp Assy
Center J/B Assy
Theft Warning ECU
Engine Room J/B
SECURITY Fuse
ECU-B Fuse
ECM
Passenger Side J/B Assy
Rear Door Lock Assy RH
Front Door Lock Assy RH
Key Unlock Warning
Switch Assy
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
ECU-IG Fuse
Front Door Courtesy Lamp
Switch Assy
Back Door Key Lock
and Unlock Switch
Front Door Lock Assy LH
Front Door Courtesy Lamp
Switch Assy
Rear Door Lock Assy LH
Rear Door Courtesy Lamp
Switch Assy
Rear Door Courtesy Lamp
Switch Assy
Back Door Lock Assy
B77253
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2211
05-2014
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
0522Y-04
PRE-CHECK
1.
OUTLINE OF THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
When the theft deterrent system is set and any of the following conditions is met, the system sounds the
horns and flashes the headlights and the taillights for approximately 1 minute. At the same time, the system
locks all the doors (If all the doors are not locked at once, the system repeats the door locking operation every
6.38 seconds during the 1-minute-alarming time).
There are 2 modes in this system; one is the active arming mode and another is the passive arming mode.
The system is set initially in the active arming mode. It can be switched to the passive arming mode by a
specified operation (See step 4).
Any of the doors (including the engine hood and back door) is unlocked or opened without the key.
*1
The battery terminal is disconnected and reconnected.
The system receives a panic signal from the transmitter. *2
*1: Only in the active arming mode.
*2: When the ignition key is not inserted into the key cylinder.
HINT:
There are 4 states in each mode: disarmed state, arming preparation state, armed state and alarm sounding
state.
(1) Disarmed state:
When the theft deterrent function does not operate.
(2) Arming preparation state:
Time from a user locks a door to leave the vehicle.
Time until transferring to the armed state.
When the theft deterrent function does not operate.
(3) Armed state:
When a user leaves the vehicle completely.
When the theft deterrent function operates.
(4) Alarm sounding state:
In this condition, once a theft is detected, the lights will flash and the horns will sound to
alert people around the vehicle to the theft.
Refer to the table for alarming method and time.
Horn
Theft deterrent horn
Alarming method
Headlight
Taillight
Alarming time
60 seconds
Alarming output
Continuous 0.40 sec. (ON)
0.40 sec. (OFF)
HINT:
In the alarm sounding state, when either of the doors is unlocked and no key is in the key cylinder, a force
lock signal is output.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2204
05-2015
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
ACTIVE ARMING MODE
Disarmed state
(No key inserted in ignition cylinder.)
Perform any of the following and the system will go to ”Arming preparation state”:
When all doors and engine hood are closed, lock all doors using the key.
When all doors and engine hood are closed, lock all doors using transmitter.
When all doors are locked, open and close any door or the engine hood,
then close and lock all doors and engine hood.
Arming preparation state
Perform any of the following and the system
will return to ”Disarmed state”:
Open any door or engine hood.
Unlock any door.
Insert key into the ignition key cylinder.
Reconnect battery.
Perform the following and the system will
go to ”Armed state”:
Allow 30 seconds to elapse when engine
hood is closed and all doors are locked.
Armed state
Perform any of the following and the system
will return to ”Disarmed state”:
Unlock doors using transmitter.
Unlock doors using key.
Insert key into ignition key cylinder
and turn ignition switch ON.
Perform any of the following and the system
will go to ”Alarm sounding state”:
Open any door.
Unlock doors without using key or
transmitter.
Open engine hood.
Reconnect battery.
Turn ignition switch ON.
Alarm Sounding State
Once a theft is detected, the lights will flash and
the horns will sound to alert people around the
vehicle to the theft (60 seconds).
Perform any of the following and the system
will return to ”Disarmed state”:
Unlock doors using transmitter.
Unlock doors using key.
Insert key into ignition key cylinder and turn
ignition switch ON.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2205
05-2016
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Indicator light output:
Condition
Indicator lamp
Disarmed state
OFF
Arming preparation state
ON
Armed state
BLINK
Alarm sounding state
ON
HINT:
Even in the disarmed state, the indicator lamp flashes, due to a signal output from the immobiliser system.
Also, the indicator light flashes whenever receiving a signal from the immobiliser system at any time
in the armed state.
Flashing frequency:
0.2 seconds (ON)
1.8 seconds (OFF)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2206
05-2017
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
PASSIVE ARMING MODE
This mode can be turned on according to the specified method (see step 4).
The initially set mode (when shipped from factory) is the active arming mode
(No passive arming mode).
Disarmed state (A)
Perform the following and the system will go to ”Disarmed state (B)”:
Insert and remove key from ignition key cylinder, and then open and close driver’s door.
Disarmed state (B)
Perform any of the followings and the system
Perform the following and the system
will return to ”Disarmed state (A)”:
will go to ”Arming preparation state”:
Push unlock switch on transmitter.
Close all doors and engine hood.
Insert key into driver’s or passenger’s door lock
cylinder and turn key to unlock position.
Insert key into ignition key cylinder.
Reconnect battery.
Arming preparation state
Perform the following and the
system will return to ”Disarmed state (B)”:
Open any door or the
engine hood.
Perform any of the following and
the system will return to ”Disarmed state (A)”:
Push unlock switch on
transmitter.
Insert key into driver’s or passenger’s door lock cylinder or back
door lock cylinder and turn key
to unlock position.
Insert the key into ignition key
cylinder.
Reconnect battery.
Continued from next page
Perform the following and the
system will go to ”Armed state”:
Allow 30 seconds to elapse
with all doors and engine hood
closed.
Continued on next page
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2207
05-2018
DIAGNOSTICS
Continued on previous page
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Continued from previous page
Armed state
Perform any of the following
and the system will return to
”Disarmed state (A)”:
Push unlock switch on
transmitter.
Insert key into driver’s or
passenger’s door lock cylinder
or back door lock cylinder, and
turn key to unlock position.
Insert key into ignition key
cylinder and turn it ON.
Run engine at 550 rpm
or faster for more than 10
seconds.
Perform any of the following
and the system will go on to
”Alarm sounding state”:
Open any door and allow entry
delay time*1 to pass.
Open engine hood.
Open back door without using
key or transmitter.
Reconnect the battery.
*1: See the ”Entry delay
function” on the next page.
Alarm sounding state
Perform the following and the
system will return to ”Armed
state”:
Allow the alarm sounding
period (60 sec.) to pass.
Perform any of the following
and the system will return to
”Disarmed state (A)”:
Push unlock switch on
transmitter.
Insert key into driver’s or
passenger’s door lock cylinder
or back door lock cylinder
and turn key to unlock position.
Insert key into ignition key
cylinder and turn it ON.
Run engine at 550 rpm
or faster for more than
10 seconds.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2208
05-2019
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Entry delay function:
HINT:
In the armed state, if any closed door is opened, entry delay time will start.
If the transferring condition (Armed state → Disarmed state) is satisfied during the entry delay time, the system will switch to the disarmed state. However if the condition is not satisfied, the system will judge it to be
a theft, and then the system will switch to the alarm sounding state.
.
Door
Close
Open
Indicator
ON
OFF
Alarming output
ON
OFF
System condition
Entry delay time
(0, 14, 30 sec.)
Armed state
Alarm sounding
state
HINT:
The entry delay time can be selected among 0, 14, 30 seconds by the customizing function.
Indicator lamp output:
Condition
Indicator
Disarmed state
OFF
Arming preparation state
ON
Armed state
(Entry delay time)
BLINK
(ON)
Alarm sounding state
ON
HINT:
Even in the disarmed state, the indicator lamp flashes, due to a signal output from the immobilizer system.
Also, the indicator flashes whenever receiving a signal from the immobilizer system at any time in the armed
state.
Flashing frequency:
0.2 seconds (ON)
1.8 seconds (OFF)
Switching to the active arming mode:
HINT:
In each state of the passive arming mode, when the switching condition to the active arming mode (disarmed
state of active arming mode → arming preparation state of active arming mode) is satisfied, the system will
switch to each state of the active arming mode. In this case, the active arming mode will continue until the
system switches to the disarmed state.
State of passive arming mode before switch
State of active arming mode after switch
Disarmed state
Arming preparation state
Arming preparation state
Arming preparation state (continuing for 30 sec.)
Armed state
(During entry delay time)
Armed state
(After alarming time has elapsed, armed state)
Alarm sounding state
After alarming time has elapsed, armed state
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2209
05-2020
DIAGNOSTICS
4.
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
CHANGING METHOD OF PASSIVE ARMING MODE
(ON or OFF)
Remove ignition key from key cylinder.
All doors are closed and unlocked.
Engine hood is opened.
Any door is locked and unlocked 3 times by
key or transmitter.
Input to vehicle
Output from vehicle
Within
30 sec.
Driver’s door is opened.
Driver’s door lock knob is locked and unlocked 3 times.
Within
2 sec.
System starts force lock once after 2 sec.
Driver’s door lock knob is unlocked.
Within
20 sec.
Driver’s door is closed and opened 2 times
Driver’s door is closed and opened 3
to 5 times
3 times
Driver’s door lock knob is locked and unlocked.
5 times
Driver’s door lock knob is locked and unlocked.
* 0 sec.
Within
2 sec.
4 times
* 14 sec.
* 30 sec.
System starts force lock once after 2 sec.
System starts force lock once after 2 sec.
PASSIVE MODE OFF
PASSIVE MODE ON
HINT:
Initial mode is PASSIVE MODE OFF.
If there is a different signal in the middle of changing. It is invalid.
*: Entry delay time
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2210
05-2023
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
0522Q-03
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Proceed to the reference page shown in the matrix chart below for each malfunction symptom and perform
a troubleshooting for each circuit.
HINT:
Troubleshooting of the theft deterrent system is based on the premise that the door lock control system is
operating normally. Accordingly, before troubleshooting the theft deterrent system, first make certain that
the door lock control system is operating normally.
Symptom
Suspected Area
See Page
Theft deterrent system cannot be set.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Indicator lamp circuit
ECU power source circuit
Key un-lock warning switch circuit
Back door key lock and unlock switch circuit
Engine hood courtesy switch circuit
Theft warning ECU
05-2024
05-2026
05-2033
05-2036
05-2038
-
Indicator lamp does not blink when theft deterrent system is set.
1. Indicator lamp circuit
05-2024
When theft deterrent system is set
(System does not operate when the engine hood is opened).
1. Engine hood courtesy switch circuit
2. Theft warning ECU
05-2038
-
When theft deterrent system is set
(It is not canceled when the ignition key is turned to ACC or ON
position).
1. Ignition switch circuit
05-2031
When theft deterrent system is set
(It is still operating when back door is opened with key).
1. Back door key lock and un-lock switch circuit
05-2036
While theft deterrent system is in warning operation
(Horns do not sound).
1. Horn circuit
05-2028
Even when theft deterrent system is not set
(Horns sound).
1. Horn circuit
05-2028
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2213
05-2022
DIAGNOSTICS
-
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
0522P-04
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY (THEFT DETERRENT ECU)
T4
B50657
(a)
Disconnect the T4 ECU connector, and check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the wire harness side connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
E (T4-29) - Body ground
+B1 (T4-2) - Body ground
+B2 (T4-3) - Body ground
L (T4-15) - Body ground
UL (T4-33)
(T4 33) - Body
B d ground
d
Wiring color
Condition
Specified Condition
W-B
Constant
- Body ground
Below 1 Ω
O- Body ground
Constant
10 to 14 V
L- Body ground
Constant
10 to 14 V
SB
Using key, back door lock cylinder
- Body ground LOCK → UNLOCK
BR
Using key, back door lock cylinder
- Body ground UNLOCK → Other position
IG (T4-10) - E (T4-29)
G - W-B
Below 1 Ω → 10 kΩ or
higher
Ignition switch OFF → ON
0V → 10 to 14 V
If the result is not as specified, there may be a malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the T4 ECU connector, and check the voltage of each terminal of the connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
DSWH (T4-34) - E (T4-29)
W - W-B
Engine hood courtesy switch
OFF (Closed) → ON (Opened)
10 to 14 V → 0 V
KSW (T4-12) - E (T4-29)
P - W-B
Key unlock warning switch
ON (Key inserted) → OFF (Key removed)
10 to 14 V → 0 V
IND (T4-25) - E (T4-29)
R - W-B
During set preparation
3 to 5 V
(Waveform)
Alarm sounding state
10 to 14 V → 0 V
(Waveform)
SH- (T4-1) - Body ground
LG
- Body ground
If the result is not as specified, the theft warning ECU assy may malfunction.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2212
05-1954
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526M-02
ALL DOORS ARE NOT OPERATED BY THE DRIVER’S DOOR KEY
CYLINDER FOR INTERLOCKED WITH KEY
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A lock or unlock signal via the manual switch (built in the master switch) and driver door key is transmitted
to the multiplex network body ECU multiply from the master switch (door ECU), and the multiplex network
body ECU drives the door lock motor of each door.
WIRING DIAGRAM
HINT:
Refer to See page 05-1944 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2144
05-1955
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSY LH
(a)
Inspect the door lock assy continuity.
Standard:
Switch position
Tester connection
Lock
2⇔4
OFF
-
Unlock
2⇔3
Unlock
Specified condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
OFF
Lock
B51545
(b)
Unlock
Lock
(c)
Inspect the door lock motor operation.
Standard:
Measuring condition
Operation
Battery positive - Terminal 5
Battery negative - Terminal 6
Lock
Battery positive - Terminal 6
Battery negative - Terminal 5
Unlock
Inspect the position switch continuity.
Standard:
Measuring condition
Tester connection
Battery positive Terminal 6
Battery negative Terminal 5
1⇔2
Specified condition
Continuity
B51546
NG
REPLACE FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSY LH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2145
05-1956
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(a)
(b)
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
Disconnect the master switch and door lock connector.
Check the continuity between the master switch and door
lock.
Standard:
Terminals (Switch ⇔ Door Lock)
Specified condition
16 ⇔ 1
Continuity
4⇔4
Continuity
14 ⇔ 3
Continuity
Front Door Lock Assy LH
B51572
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2146
05-1944
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526J-03
B1222/22 DOOR LOCK SWITCH CIRCUIT ON DRIVER
DOOR
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC will be output when the driver door unlock switch (for key operation) of the power window regulator
master switch assy is on.
DTC No
DTC Detecting Condition
B1222/22
Trouble Area
Power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU)
Front door lock assy LH (driver side)
Multiplex network body ECU
Stick of key lock and unlock switch
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network
Body ECU (Body ECU)
P5
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
9
W-L
Instrument
Panel J/B
Assy
L-W
10
R-L
20
CPUB
MPX2
1
8 GR
IB2
5
IF3
Y
O
BDR
MPX1
SIG
GND
KL
KUL LSWE
4
2
14
7
10
B9 MPX2
6
B10 MPX1
MPX Line
LSW
3
16
W-B
2 IB1
Passenger Side
Junction Block Assy
6
4M
8
4L
G
Y
LG
BR
4
3
2
1
L
UL
E
LSSR
L
5
IB1
5
W
W-B
UL
6
R
J5
J/B
B
B
L
4
IB1
L
BR
1
B12 ACT+
2
B12 ACTD
W-B
D12
Front Door Lock Assy LH (Driver Side)
Instrument Panel
J/B Assy
4
1E
14
1D
W-B
IA
B78721
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2134
05-1945
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC CODE OUTPUT
Check if code B1222/22 will disappear but only B1211/11 (communication stop) will be output when
the master switch connector is disconnected.
(1) B1222/22 code output, proceed to A.
(2) B1211/11 code output, proceed to B.
B
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2135
05-1946
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSY LH
(a)
Inspect the door lock assy continuity.
Standard:
Switch Position
Tester Connection
Lock
3⇔5
OFF
-
Unlock
4⇔5
Unlock
Specified Condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
OFF
Lock
B51545
(b)
Unlock
Lock
(c)
Inspect the door lock motor operation.
Standard:
Measuring Condition
Operation
Battery positive - Terminal 1
Battery negative - Terminal 2
Lock
Battery positive - Terminal 2
Battery negative - Terminal 1
Unlock
Inspect the position switch continuity.
Standard:
Measuring Condition
Tester Connection
Battery positive Terminal 2
Battery negative Terminal 1
1⇔2
Specified Condition
Continuity
B61505
NG
REPLACE FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSY RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2136
05-1947
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(a)
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
(b)
Disconnect the connector from the master switch and
front door lock motor LH.
Check the connector on the harness side.
Continuity:
Tester Connection (Switch ⇔ Motor)
Specified Condition
4⇔4
Continuity
14 ⇔ 3
Continuity
(c)
Check the master switch connector on the wire harness
side.
Continuity:
Front Door Lock Motor Assy
(Driver Side)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
4 ⇔ Body ground
No continuity
14 ⇔ Body ground
No continuity
Voltage:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
4 ⇔ Body ground
0V
14 ⇔ Body ground
0V
B52424
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2137
05-1948
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526K-02
B1223/23 POWER WINDOW SWITCH CIRCUIT ON
PASSENGER DOOR
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when any switch of the door control switch is on.
DTC No
B1223/23
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Power window regulator switch assy (passenger side)
Multiplex network body ECU
Stick of power window switch
WIRING DIAGRAM
P10
Power Window Regulator Switch Assy
(Passenger Side)
SU
SD
Multiplex Network
Body ECU
4
Y
11
IN2
B
21
B10 PU
5
LG
4
IN2
GR
20
B10 PD
B78722
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2138
05-1949
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSY (PASSENGER’S SIDE)
(a)
Inspect the power window switch continuity.
Switch Position
Tester Connection
Up
3-5
OFF
-
Down
4-5
Specified Condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
B31305
NG
REPLACE POWER
SWITCH ASSY
WINDOW
REGULATOR
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the connector from the door control switch.
Check the connector on the wire harness side.
Continuity:
Tester Connection
8 7 6 5 4
Specified Condition
1 ⇔ Body ground
Continuity
4 ⇔ Body ground
No continuity
5 ⇔ Body ground
No continuity
Voltage:
B51844
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 ⇔ Body ground
0V
4 ⇔ Body ground
0V
5 ⇔ Body ground
0V
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2139
05-1950
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526L-04
B1224/24 Door lock switch circuit on passenger door
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when the passenger door unlock switch (for key operation) of the door control switch is
on.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
B1224/24
Trouble Area
Door control switch assy (passenger side)
Front door lock assy RH
Multiplex network body ECU
Stick of key lock and unlock switch
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network
Body ECU
D13
Front Door Lock Assy RH
W-B
2
IN1
L
W-B
5
GR
1
IN2
V
8
B10 PKL
V
8
IN2
SB
13
B10 PKUL
BR
2
IN2
BR
11
B10 LSWP
3
E
UL
10 4L
4
Passenger Side
J/B
LSSR
6 4M
6
W-B
L
W
1
5
IN1
J5
J/C
L
L
B
4 1E
Instrument Panel
J/B Assy
UL
R
2
4
IN1
B
J5
J/C
W
C
C
1
B12 ACT+
B-W
6
W
B12 ACT-
14 1D
W-B
IA
B78720
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2140
05-1951
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT DOOR CONTROL SWITCH ASSY
(a)
Inspect the door control switch continuity.
Switch Position
Tester Connection
Lock
3-6
OFF
-
Unlock
3-5
2
1
6 5 4 3
Specified Condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
B51554
NG
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL SWITCH ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2141
05-1952
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSY RH
(a)
Inspect the door lock assy continuity.
Standard:
Switch Position
Tester Connection
Lock
3⇔5
OFF
-
Unlock
4⇔5
Unlock
Specified Condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
OFF
Lock
B51543
(b)
Unlock
(c)
Lock
Inspect the door lock motor operation.
Standard:
Measuring Condition
Operation
Battery positive - Terminal 1
Battery negative - Terminal 2
Lock
Battery positive - Terminal 2
Battery negative - Terminal 1
Unlock
Inspect the position switch continuity.
Standard:
Measuring Condition
Tester Connection
Battery positive Terminal 2
Battery negative Terminal 1
5⇔6
Specified Condition
Continuity
B51544
NG
REPLACE FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSY RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2142
05-1953
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(a)
Multiplex Network Body ECU
(b)
Disconnect the connector from the body ECU B10 connector and front door lock assy RH connector.
Check the connector on the wire harness side.
Continuity:
B10
(c)
Front Door Lock Assy RH
Tester Connection
(Body ECU ⇔ Door Lock)
Specified Condition
B10-8 ⇔ 3
Continuity
B10-13 ⇔ 4
Continuity
Check the master switch connector on the wire harness
side.
Continuity:
Tester Connection
(Body ECU or Door Lock
⇔ Body ground)
Specified Condition
B10-8 or 3 ⇔ Body ground
No continuity
B10-13 or 4 ⇔ Body ground
No continuity
Voltage:
Tester Connection
(Body ECU or Door Lock
⇔ Body ground)
Specified Condition
B10-8 or 3 ⇔ Body ground
0V
B10-13 or 4 ⇔ Body ground
0V
B61507
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2143
05-1957
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526N-02
KEY CONFINEMENT PREVENTION FUNCTION DOES NOT WORK
PROPERLY (MANUAL OPERATION AND INTERLOCKED WITH
KEY ARE ACTIVE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multiplex network body ECU senses, by the un-lock warning switch, that the ignition key is in the key
cylinder. Because of this, the multiplex network body ECU will unlock all the doors immediately after locking
them if a door has been locked while the key is in the ignition key cylinder.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network
Body ECU
K4
Un-lock Warning
Switch Assy
Passenger Side J/B
W-B
W-B
7
4L
9
4G
G
W-B
1
1
4N
J6
J/C
2
G
D
D
D7
Front Door Courtesy
Lamp Switch Assy (Driver Side)
9
B
IA1
1
IC
B
2
B10 KSW
11
B11 DCTY
Combination Meter Assy
9
MPX+ C12
SB
21
C11
Y
MPX Line
W
6
B10 MPX1
O
10
B9
Door Open
Indicator
MPX-
MPX Line
MPX2
B78723
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2147
05-1958
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MANUAL DOOR LOCK OPERATION
NG
GO TO POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
(See page 05-1912 )
OK
2
INSPECT UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY
(a)
OFF
ON
Inspect the un-lock warning switch continuity.
Standard:
Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Switch OFF
(Key removed)
-
No continuity
Switch ON
(Key set)
1⇔2
Continuity
B52271
NG
REPLACE UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY
OK
3
CHECK MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
(a)
B10
Disconnect the multiplex network body ECU B10 connector and inspect the body ECU B10-2 terminal.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B10-2 ⇔ Body ground
Constant
12 - 14 V
B61511
NG
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2148
05-1959
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(a)
Wire Harness Side
Disconnect the un-lock warning switch connector and inspect the connector on the wire harness side.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
2 ⇔ Body ground
Constant
10 - 14 V
1 ⇔ Body ground
Constant
Continuity
B51904
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
5
(a)
CHECK DOOR OPEN WARNING LIGHT
Check that the door open warning light will be on when the driver door is opened.
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
NG
6
(a)
INSPECT FRONT DOOR COURTESY LAMP SWITCH ASSY
Inspect the door courtesy lamp switch continuity.
Standard:
Switch Position
Specified Condition
ON (switch pin released: opened door)
Continuity
OFF (switch pin pushed in: closed door)
No continuity
NG
REPLACE FRONT DOOR COURTESY LAMP
SWITCH ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS (COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH - BODY ECU)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2149
05-1937
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526D-02
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
Registration No.
Registration Year
Customer’s Name
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought in
/
/
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Frequency Problem Occurs
Problem Symptom
Weather Conditions
When Problem
Occurred
km
miles
Odometer Reading
Constant
Once only
/
Sometimes (
Times per day, month)
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Various/Others
Hot
Warm
Cool
Outdoor temperature
Cold (Approx.
C (
F))
Weather
Snowy
Malfunction in Door
Lock/Unlock Operation
Using Door Lock Control
Switch.
Driver side door lock control switch.
Driver side door
Passenger side door
Passenger side door key
lock and unlock control
switch.
Driver side door
Passenger side door
Malfunction in Door
Lock/Unlock Operation
Using Key.
Driver side door key lock
and unlock control switch.
Driver side door
Passenger side door
Passenger side door key
lock and unlock control
switch.
Driver side door
Passenger side door
2-operation unlock function of driver side door key lock
and unlock switch.
Malfunction in Key Lock-In Prevention Function.
Malfunction in Luggage Compartment Door Opener Function.
Others.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2127
05-1939
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526F-02
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code in the table
below (Proceed to the page given for that circuit.).
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
B1224/24
(05-1950 )
Open Door Warning Light
Power window regulator master switch assy
(door ECU)
Front door lock assy RH (driver side)
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Blinks
Power window switch circuit on passenger door
Door control switch assy (passenger side)
Multiplex Network Body Body ECU
Blinks
Door lock switch circuit on passenger door
Door control switch assy (passenger side)
Front door lock assy RH (passenger side)
Multiplex Network Body Body ECU
Blinks
Door lock switch circuit on driver door
B1222/22
(05-1944 )
B1223/23
(05-1948 )
Trouble Area
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2129
05-1935
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526C-02
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
2
SYMPTOM CHECK
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF LARGE-SCALE MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)
(a)
Check that there is no abnormality in the communication system by inspecting the communication
function of the multiplex communication system with the hand-held tester.
(1) (ECU unconnected, communication line abnormal) Without code output, proceed to A.
(2) (ECU unconnected, communication line abnormal) With code output, proceed to B.
B
GO TO MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SECTION
A
4
(a)
DIAGNOSIS CODE CHECK (See page 05-1939 )
Check diagnosis code.
(1) Without code output, proceed to A.
(2) With code output, proceed to B.
B
GO TO DTC CHART (See page 05-1939 )
A
5
(a)
(b)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (See page 05-1943 )
Without applicable symptoms, proceed to A.
With applicable symptoms, proceed to B.
B
GO TO SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
6
(a)
(b)
PERFORM TROUBLESHOOTING IN THE FOLLOWING METHOD, DEPENDING ON
MALFUNCTION SYMPTOM
Pre-inspection (See page 05-1938 )
(1) Inspection with the hand-held tester (ECU DATA MONITOR)
ECU terminal position
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2125
05-1936
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
ADJUSTMENT, REPAIR OR REPLACEMENT
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2126
05-1940
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526G-01
LOCATION
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Door Control Switch Assy
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
Front Door Lock Assy RH
Front Door Lock Assy LH
Rear Door Lock Assy RH
Front Door Courtesy Lamp
Switch Assy
Front Door Courtesy Lamp
Switch Assy
Back Door Lock Assy
Rear Door Lock Assy LH
B51123
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2130
05-1934
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526B-01
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
NOTICES OF REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OPERATIONS
Before performing operations related to the door lock and door lock cylinder, be sure to disconnect the
battery terminal or the connector of the window regulator motor.
CAUTION:
If the operation is performed with the connectors being connected, the door control switch inside
the door lock might be unexpectedly actuated, which results in injury.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2124
05-1938
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526E-01
PRE-CHECK
1.
USING HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Hook up the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Monitor the ECU data by following the prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
Hand-held tester has a ”Snapshot” function which records the monitored data.
Refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
2.
DTC CLEAR
(a) The DTCs and freeze frame data will be erased by the hand-held tester to erase the codes.
3.
DATA LIST
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as a first step of
troubleshooting is one of the method to shorten the labor time.
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Standard (Body ECU):
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
KEY SW
Key unlock warning
SW signal/ON or OFF
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ON: Key is IG key cylinder
OFF: Key is not in IG key cylinder
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2128
05-1943
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526I-03
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspected Area
See Page
All doors are not operated by driver’s door key cylinder for interlocked with key
1.
2.
3.
4.
Body ECU monitor code
Front door lock assy RH (driver side)
Wire harness
Power window regulator master switch assy (Door ECU)
05-1954
Key confinement prevention function does not work properly
(Manual operation and operation interlocked with key are active)
1.
2.
3.
4.
Un-lock warning switch assy
Wire harness
Door open warning Light (built in combination meter)
Front door courtesy lamp switch assy (driver side)
05-1957
Door lock system does not operate at all
1. Door 20 A fuse
2. Multiplex Network Body ECU
3. Wire harness
05-2046
Door lock system does not operate by manual switch
1. Power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU)
(Door control switch for manual operation)
2. Multiplex Network Body ECU
3. Wire harness
05-2046
Fault in key confinement prevention operate
1.
2.
3.
4.
05-1957
Only one door lock does not operate
1. Door lock assy
2. Wire harness
73-3
Fault in 2-operation unlock function of driver side door key lock
and unlock switch
1.
2.
3.
4.
73-3
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Un-lock warning switch assy
Front door courtesy lamp switch assy (driver side)
Wire harness
Door key lock and unlock switch circuit
Power window regulator master switch assy (Door ECU)
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Wire harness
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2133
05-1941
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526H-04
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
(a)
(b)
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSY (DOOR ECU)
Disconnect the master switch connector.
Check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the wire harness side connector.
P5
B51555
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
SIG (P5-20) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
R-L ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch OFF → ON
Condition
0 V → 10 - 14 V
Specified Condition
BDR (P5-10) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
L-W ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
CPUB (P5-9) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
W-L ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
KL (P5-4) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
G ⇔ W-B
Driver side door lock key cylinder OFF → LOCK
10 - 14 V → Below 0 V
KUL (P5-14) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
Y ⇔ W-B
Driver side door lock key cylinder OFF → UNLOCK
10 - 14 V → Below 0 V
LSW (P5-16) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
BR ⇔ W-B
Driver side door LOCK → UNLOCK
10 - 14 V → Below 0 V
LSWE (P5-3) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
LG ⇔ W-B
Constant
Continuity
GND (P5-2) ⇔ Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Continuity
If the result is not as specified, there may be a malfunction on the wire harness side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2131
05-1942
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
BODY ECU
B11
B12
B10
B9
B51569
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the body ECU connectors B12, B10 and B9.
Check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the wire harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
BDR1 (B12-4) ⇔ Body ground
IG (B9-5) ⇔ Body ground
Wiring Color
B⇔ BR ⇔ -
Condition
Specified Condition
Constant
10 - 14 V
Ignition switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 - 14 V
Constant
Continuity
GND1 (B12-7) ⇔ Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
KSW (B10-2) ⇔ Body ground
G⇔-
No key in the ignition key cylinder → With key
No continuity → Continuity
ACC (B9-17) ⇔ Body ground
B⇔ -
Ignition switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 - 14 V
BECU (B12-9) ⇔ Body ground
G⇔-
Constant
10 - 14 V
(c)
Reconnect the body ECU connectors, and check the voltage of each terminal of the connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
DCTY (B11-1 1) ⇔ Body ground
B⇔-
Driver door CLOSED → OPEN
10 - 14 V → Below 0 V
KSW (B10-2) ⇔ Body ground
G⇔ -
No key in the ignition key cylinder → With key
10 - 14 V → Below 0 V
ACT+ (B12-1) ⇔ Body ground
L⇔-
Master switch and driver’s door key cylinder OFF → LOCK
0 V → 10 - 14 V → 0 V
PCTY (B12-16) ⇔ Body ground
SB ⇔ -
Passenger door CLOSED → OPEN
10 - 14 V → Below 0 V
RCTY (B12-15) ⇔ Body ground
LG ⇔ -
Rear door (RH, LH) CLOSED → OPEN
10 - 14 V → Below 0 V
ACT- (B12-6) ⇔ Body ground
W⇔-
Master switch and driver’s door key cylinder
OFF → UNLOCK
0 V → 10 - 14 V → 0 V
If the result is not as specified, there may be a malfunction on the wire harness side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2132
05-1970
DIAGNOSTICS
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526W-03
ONLY WIRELESS CONTROL FUNCTION IS INOPERATIVE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The door control receiver receives a signal from transmitter and sends it to body ECU by line.
And the body ECU transmits the signal to the door lock assembly to control the door lock/unlock operation.
NOTICE:
The wireless door lock control system has a function with a large-scale multiplex communication
system. First of all, inspect the communication function depending on the ”HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING”, and check that the communication system has no malfunction. Then finally
proceed with the troubleshooting. Also, in case that the wire harness between the body ECU and door
control receiver has been short-circuited, diagnostic code 42 will be output and the wireless control
will not function.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
The initial condition that the customizing function by the hand-held tester is not chosen is shown.
1.
VEHICLE’S INITIAL CONDITION (CONDITION OF WIRELESS CONTROL POSSIBLE)
(a) No key in the ignition key cylinder.
(b) All doors closed (door open indicator off).
(c) All doors locked.
HINT:
The switch described in this text is a LOCK/ UNLOCK switch for transmitting, and it is built in the door control
transmitter.
1
CHECK TRANSMITTER BATTERY SIMPLY
(a) Check that the LED of the transmitter lights up 3 times when the switch has been pressed 3 times.
HINT:
If the LED does not light up when the switch has been pressed 3 times or more, it may be caused by the
dead battery. Replace the battery with a new or normal one, and then check that doors will be locked or unlocked by the standard operation.
NOTICE:
Standard operation means to press and hold the transmitter switch for 1 second, facing the transmitter to the vehicle, in 1 m (3.28 ft) away from the driver’s door outside handle in the right direction.
NG
REPLACE TRANSMITTER (LITHIUM) BATTERY
OK
2
CONFIRM ROOM LAMP ON
(a) Check that the room lamp comes on.
HINT:
When the lamp does not come on, proceed with the self-diagnostic mode after repairing the room lamp.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2160
05-1971
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
ENTER INTO SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a)
Enter into the self-diagnostic mode by operating the ignition switch lock cylinder.
(1) Insert the key into the ignition switch lock cylinder under the vehicle’s initial condition, and then
operate the ignition switch assembly OFF → ON → OFF once within 5 seconds after the key is
pulled out.
(2) Within 30 seconds after the ignition switch assembly is turned OFF, operate the ignition switch
assembly OFF → ON → OFF 9 times.
NOTICE:
The mode returns to the normal mode if even one of the above conditions has not been met.
HINT:
The operation of the ignition switch assembly OFF → ON will finish the self-diagnostic mode.
Do not carry out the lock/unlock operations during the self-diagnostic mode.
(b) Check that the system has entered into the self-diagnostic mode by blinks of the room lamp.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2161
05-1972
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK BY SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
Check the output of the DTC when the door control transmitter switch has been kept pressed
(The DTC output can be checked by the output of the room lamp).
HINT:
In case of a reception of the normal wave of the LOCK/UNLOCK switch (room lamp blinking) and no
DTC outputs (room lamp off), go to step A.
In case of discord of recognition code (room lamp on), go to step B.
Normal wave of lock and unlock switch is received
Room Lamp Output
ON
OFF
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
Discord of recognition code
Room Lamp Output
ON
OFF
Wave Receiving
No DTC is output
Room Lamp Output
OFF
B51906
B
Go to step 7
A
5
(a)
CHECK THE WAVE REACHING RANGE
Check that the diagnosis will be output when a new or normal door control transmitter switch for a same
type vehicle, has been pressed.
OK
REPLACE TRANSMITTER SUB-ASSY MODULE
SET DOOR CONTROL
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2162
05-1973
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
Door Control
Receiver
W6
Check the DOME fuse.
Disconnect the W6 receiver connector.
Check the voltage or continuity between the W6 receiver
wire harness side connector and body ground.
Standard:
Terminal No.
Specified condition
5 - Body ground
10 - 14 V
1 - Body ground
Continuity
B51930
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUSE
HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
OR
WIRE
OK
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
7
(a)
RE-REGISTER RECOGNITION CODE OF TRANSMITTER
Check if it is possible to enter into the rewrite mode or the add mode for the recognition code registration, and if a recognition code can be registered, as well.
NG
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
OK
NORMAL (FUNCTION)
8
CONFIRM INPUT METHOD OF SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
NG
Go to step 3
OK
9
INSPECT UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY (See page 05-1957 )
NG
REPLACE UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2163
05-1968
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
42
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526V-05
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK RECEIVER
CIRCUIT MALFUNCTIONS
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The door control receiver locks the doors via the wireless control by receiving and sending input/output signals from the body ECU.
DTC No.
42
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
In diagnostic mode, reception of applicable RDA signal is impossible within 1 second after PRG signal has been output
from body ECU.
Wireless door control receiver
Wire harness
Body ECU
HINT:
In this circuit, the diagnostic mode means that the door open indicator inside the meter will blink by turning
the ignition switch ON after short-circuited between terminals 13 (TC) and 4 (CG) of the DLC3 by SST.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Body ECU
W6
Door Control Receiver
PRG
W-B
1
E
A
+B
J19
J/C
A
RDA
BR
Y
IO2
15
3
SB
GR
IO2
14
J18
J/C
2
B
5
B11 PRG
17
B11 RDA
16
B
D
D
A
10 IO2
R
W-B
W-B
To Battery
BB
BF
B74777
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2158
05-1969
DIAGNOSTICS
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU ⇔ DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER)
Wire Harness Side
MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
(a)
(b)
(c)
B11
(d)
RDA
PRG
Door Control Receiver
W6
5 4 3 2 1
PRG
Disconnect the B11 ECU connector.
Disconnect the W6 receiver connector.
Check the continuity between the B11 ECU and W6 receiver wire harness side connectors.
Standard (OPEN):
Symbol (Terminal No.)
Specified condition
RDA (B11-16) ⇔ RDA (W6-2)
Continuity
PRG (B11-17) ⇔ PRG (W6-3)
Continuity
Check the continuity between the B11 ECU or W6 receiver wire harness side connectors and body ground.
Standard (SHORT):
Symbol (Terminal No.)
Specified condition
RDA (B11-16) or RDA (W6-2)
⇔ Body ground
No continuity
PRG (B11-17) or PRG (W6-3)
⇔ Body ground
No continuity
RDA
B51905
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2
(a)
(b)
CHECK DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
Check that the wireless system operates when connected to a new or normal door control receiver.
Check if no diagnosis has been output.
Standard: No diagnosis has been output
OK
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
NG
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2159
05-1962
DIAGNOSTICS
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526P-03
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL System Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
Registration No.
Customer’s Name
Registration Year
/
/
Frame No.
/
Date Vehicle Brought In
/
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Frequency Problem Occurs
Weather
Weather Conditions
When Problem Occurred
Outdoor Temperature
Place
km
miles
Odometer Reading
/
Constant
Sometimes ( times/per
day, month)
Once only
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Snowy
Various/Others
Warm
Hot
Cold (Approx.
°C (
Cool
°F))
Specific Locality(
Everywhere
/
Date Transmitter Battery Last Replaced
)
/
Whole wireless door lock control system does not operate.
Problem Symptom
Only door unlock operation is impossible.
Only door lock operation is impossible.
Only key confinement prevention function is impossible.
Wireless door lock function operates even when each door is opened.
Wireless door lock functions incorrectly.
( Although one door is unlocked, when the transmitter switch is pressed, all doors become unlocked.)
When RH door is unlocked.
When LH door is unlocked.
Others
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2152
05-1964
DIAGNOSTICS
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526R-02
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code in the table
below (Proceed to the page given for that circuit).
DTC No.
(See Page)
42
(05-1968 )
Detection Item
Wireless door lock receiver circuit
malfunctions
Open Door Warning
Light
Trouble Area
Wire harness
Wireless door lock receiver
Body ECU
Blinks
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2154
05-1960
DIAGNOSTICS
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526O-02
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS AND SYMPTOM CHECK (See page 05-1962 )
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF LARGE-SCALE MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)
(a)
Check that there is no abnormality in the communication system by inspecting the communication
function of the body multiplex communication system with the hand-held tester.
(1) (ECU unconnected, communication line abnormal) Without code output, proceed to A.
(2) (ECU unconnected, communication line abnormal) With code output, proceed to B.
B
GO TO BODY MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SECTION (See page 05-2040 )
A
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (See page 05-1964 )
Check a DTC and note it down if a code is output.
Delete the DTC.
Check if the DTC will be output once again, when the problem symptom is simulated based on the
noted code.
(1) Without an output of the code, proceed to A.
(2) With an output of the code, proceed to B.
B
Go to step 7
A
5
(a)
(b)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (See page 05-1967 )
Without applicable symptoms, proceed to A.
With applicable symptoms, proceed to B.
B
Go to step 7
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2150
05-1961
DIAGNOSTICS
6
(a)
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
PERFORM TROUBLESHOOTING IN THE FOLLOWING METHOD, DEPENDING ON
MALFUNCTION SYMPTOM
Pre-check (See page 05-1963 ).
(1) Inspection with the hand-held tester (ECU DATA MONITOR).
(2) Inspection with the hand-held tester (ACTIVE TEST).
Terminals of ECU (See page 05-1966 ).
(b)
7
ADJUSTMENT, REPAIR OR REPLACEMENT
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2151
05-1965
DIAGNOSTICS
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526S-02
LOCATION
Multiplex Network Body ECU (Body ECU)
Door Control Switch Assembly
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assembly
Front Door Lock Assembly RH
Front Door Lock
Assembly LH
Rear Door Lock Assembly RH
Door Control Receiver
Front Door Courtesy
Lamp Switch Assembly
Rear Door Courtesy
Lamp Switch Assembly
Front Door Courtesy
Lamp Switch Assembly
Back Door
Lock Assembly
Rear Door Courtesy
Lamp Switch Assembly
Rear Door Lock Assembly LH
B51134
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2155
05-1963
DIAGNOSTICS
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526Q-03
PRE-CHECK
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT WITH HAND-HELD TESTER
ECU Data Monitor (MPX Body ECU)
(1) The ECU data monitor will indicate if the part is normal or malfunction.
Item
Inspecting condition
Standard value
KEY SW
Ignition ON → No key
ON → OFF
Customizing Function (reference)
(1) The use of the hand-held tester makes it possible to select the following controls on the door
lock.
Item
Setting
Wireless door lock operation
With/ Without function
Automatic locking time
30 sec. / 60 sec.
Room lamp on when door unlocked via wireless control
With/ Without function
Open door warning
ON / OFF
Alarm function
ON / OFF
2 times operation wireless unlock
ON / OFF
Unlock with 2 times driver’s door key operation
ON / OFF
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2153
05-1967
DIAGNOSTICS
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526U-02
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
All functions of wireless door lock control system are inoperative
(only wireless control function is inoperative).
Suspected Area
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
See page
Transmitter battery
Door control transmitter
Door control receiver
DOME fuse
Body ECU
Un-lock warning SW
Wire harness
05-1970
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2157
05-1966
DIAGNOSTICS
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
0526T-04
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU (BODY ECU)
B12
B11
B10
B9
B61267
(a)
Disconnect the B9, B10 and B12 ECU connectors, and check the voltage or continuity of each terminal
of the wire harness side connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring color
BDR1 (B12-4) ⇔
Body ground
B⇔ -
IG (B9-5) ⇔
Body ground
BR⇔ -
GND1 (B12-7) ⇔
Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
KSW (B10-2) ⇔
Body ground
Condition
Specified condition
Constant
10 - 14 V
Ignition switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 - 14 V
Constant
Continuity
G⇔ -
No key in ignition key cylinder → With key
No continuity → Continuity
ACC (B9-17) ⇔
Body ground
B⇔ -
Ignition switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 - 14 V
BECU (B12-9) ⇔
Body ground
G⇔ -
Constant
10 - 14 V
If the result is not as specified, there may be a malfunction the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the B9, B10 and B12 ECU connectors, and check the voltage of each terminal of the connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring color
DCTY (B11-1 1) ⇔
Body ground
Condition
Specified condition
B⇔ -
Driver’s door CLOSED → OPEN
10 - 14 V → Below 1 V
KSW (B10-2) ⇔
Body ground
G⇔ -
No key in ignition key cylinder → With key
10 - 14 V → Below 1 V
ACT+ (B12-1) ⇔
Body ground
L⇔ -
Master switch and driver’s door key cylinder OFF → LOCK
0 V → 10 - 14 V → 0 V
PCTY (B12-16) ⇔
Body ground
SB⇔ -
Passenger’s door CLOSED → OPEN
10 - 14 V → Below 1 V
RCTY (B12-15) ⇔
Body ground
LG⇔ -
Rear door (RH, LH) CLOSED → OPEN
10 - 14 V → Below 1 V
ACT- (B12-6) ⇔
Body ground
W⇔ -
Master switch and driver’s door key cylinder
OFF → UNLOCK
0 V → 10 - 14 V → 0 V
If the result is not as specified, the theft warning ECU assy may malfunction.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2156
05-2051
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
0523X-05
B1211/11 DRIVER DOOR ECU COMMUNICATION
STOP
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
B1211/11 will be output when the communication between the power window regulator master switch assy
(door ECU) and multiplex network body ECU stops for more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
B1211/11
DTC Detection Condition
Door ECU communication stop
Trouble Area
Power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU)
Wire harness
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2241
05-2052
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
B9
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Engine Room J/B
ECU-B
2I
1
2A
4
D.C.C
W-L
IC3 5
W
Y
Y
V
1D
Instrument
Panel J/B
6 1K
G
10
P5
Power Window
BDR
Regulator Master
Switch Assy
(Door ECU)
B
3
BR
IB1 3
1 1A
IF3 5
BR
1G 10
8
IL1
FR
Door
MPX2
10
O
IB2 1
IB2 2
L
9
GR
8
MPX2
2
GND
CPUB
MPX1
7
V
W-B
IB2 8
IB1 2
3
2
SB
F7
FL Block
Assy
ALT
W-B
4F
8
4L
7
Passenger
Side J/B
1
4L 7
4A 5
W
Passenger
Side J/B
BR
S31 2
FL Main
Short
Connector
W-B
S30 2
BR
22
Battery
A17
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
MPX2
IC
H45686
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2242
05-2053
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK CONTINUITY OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Check the wire harness between the multiplex network body ECU, power window regulator master
switch assy (door ECU) and airbag sensor assembly.
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
A17
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
Multiplex Network Body ECU
P5
B9
H45693
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2243
05-2054
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(1)
(2)
Disconnect the connectors of the master switch, body ECU and air conditioner amplifier.
Check the continuity between terminal P5-8 (MPX2) of the master switch vehicle’s side connector and terminal B9-10 (MPX2) of the body ECU vehicle’s side connector.
Standard: Continuity
(3) Check the continuity between terminal P5-7 (MPX1) of the master switch vehicle’s side connector and terminal A17-22 (MPX2) of the airbag sensor assembly vehicle’s side connector.
Standard: Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSY
(a)
P5
Inspect the power window regulator master switch assy
(door ECU) (power source input).
(1) Disconnect the master switch connector.
(2) Check the voltage of each terminal of the master
switch vehicle’s side connector.
B51827
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Condition
Specified Condition
CPUB (P5-9) ⇔ Body ground
Constant
10 - 14 V
BDR (P5-10) ⇔ Body ground
Constant
10 - 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUSE
HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
OR
WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2244
05-2055
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSY
(a)
P5
B51828
Inspect the power window regulator master switch assy
(door ECU) P5-2 (GND).
(1) Disconnect the master switch connector.
(2) Check the continuity between terminal P5-2 (GND)
of the master switch and the body ground.
Standard: Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2245
05-2056
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1214
DOOR SYSTEM COMMUNICATION BUS
MALFUNCTION (+B SHORT)
DTC
B1215
DOOR SYSTEM COMMUNICATION BUS
MALFUNCTION (GND SHORT)
0523Y-04
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
B1214 and B1215 will be output when +B and body ground is short-circuited on the communication bus.
Detecting this condition will make all the BEAN communication unable and output some DTCs.
DTC No.
B1214
B1215
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Communication circuit and +B battery system short
Power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU)
ECM
Air conditioner amplifier assy (A/C ECU)
Combination meter assy (meter ECU)
Theft warning ECU assy (theft deterrent ECU)
Sliding roof drive gear sub-assy (sliding roof ECU)
Wire harness
Multiplex network body ECU
Communication circuit and body ground short
Power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU)
ECM
Air conditioner amplifier assy (A/C ECU)
Combination meter assy (meter ECU)
Theft warning ECU assy (theft deterrent)
Sliding roof drive gear sub-assy (sliding roof ECU)
Wire harness
Multiplex network body ECU
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2246
05-2057
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Network Body ECU
MPX2
B9 10
MPX1
B10 6
O
IF3
W
5
18
Y
MPX1
E6
ECM
IB2 1
GR
MPX2
8
MPX2
MPX1
V
7
P5
Power Window
Regulator Master
Switch Assy
(Door ECU)
29
GR
GR
GR
IB2 8
IE1 6
IL2 1
SB
Y
SB
10
MPX1
7 4F
Passenger
Side J/B
C12 9
MPX+
Combination
Meter Assy
5 4A
MPXC11 21
BR
2
S31
Short
1 Connector
S20
Sub Assy
(Sliding Roof ECU)
Y
1 3E
R
Center J/B
IL2 12
12 3J 5 3H
G
2
A11
9
MPXA10
MPX+
Air Conditioner
Amplifier Assy
G
V
31
MPX1
T4
Theft Warning ECU Assy
(Theft deterrent ECU)
B78727
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2247
05-2058
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (A ECU)
Check whether the output of the DTC will stop when the A ECU connector is disconnected.
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
A ECU
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
B ECU
C ECU
B61052
NOTICE:
Disconnect the connectors in the operational sequence, and start the next operation after the connector is connected.
HINT:
In this case, the A ECU represents the power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU).
Standard: The disconnected A ECU is abnormal when the output of the DTC stops.
OK
REPLACE A ECU
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2248
05-2059
DIAGNOSTICS
2
(a)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (B ECU)
Check whether the output of the DTC will stop when the B ECU connector is disconnected.
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
A ECU
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
B ECU
C ECU
B61053
NOTICE:
Disconnect the connectors in the operational sequence, and start the next operation after the connector is connected.
HINT:
In this case, the B ECU represents the sliding roof drive gear sub-assy (sliding roof ECU), combination meter
assy (meter ECU), air conditioner amplifier assy (A/C ECU) or theft warning ECU assy (theft deterrent).
Standard: The disconnected B ECU or the wire harness between the A ECU and B ECU is abnormal when the output of the DTC stops.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2249
05-2060
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS BETWEEN A ECU AND B ECU
Inspect short-circuit in +B or body ground.
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
A ECU
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
B ECU
C ECU
B61054
(1) Check whether the DTC will be output when the A ECU connector is connected.
NOTICE:
Disconnect the connectors in the operational sequence, and start the next operation after the connector is connected.
OK
REPLACE B ECU
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE
BETWEEN A ECU AND B ECU
HARNESS
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2250
05-2061
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (C ECU)
Check whether the output of the DTC will stop when the A ECU connector is connected and the C ECU
connector is disconnected.
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
B ECU
C ECU
A ECU
B60307
NOTICE:
Disconnect the connectors in the operational sequence, and start the next operation when the connector is connected.
HINT:
In this case, the C ECU represents the ECM.
Standard: The disconnected C ECU or the wire harness between the B ECU and C ECU is abnormal when the output of the DTC stops.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2251
05-2062
DIAGNOSTICS
5
(a)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS BETWEEN B ECU AND C ECU
Inspect short-circuit in +B or body ground.
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
A ECU
B ECU
Communication Circuit
C ECU
B60306
(1) Check whether the DTC will be output when the B ECU connector is connected.
NOTICE:
Disconnect the connectors in the operational sequence, and start the next operation after the connector is connected.
OK
REPLACE C ECU
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE
BETWEEN B ECU AND C ECU
HARNESS
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2252
05-2063
DIAGNOSTICS
6
(a)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS MPX BODY ECU AND A ECU OR C ECU
Inspect short-circuit in +B or body ground.
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
Communication Circuit
A ECU
B ECU
Communication Circuit
C ECU
B60308
(1)
(2)
Disconnect the connectors of the A ECU and multiplex network body ECU.
Inspect short-circuit in +B of the wire harness between the A ECU and multiplex network body
ECU, and also in the body ground.
Standard:
0 V when short-circuited in +B.
No continuity between each ECU terminal and the body ground when short-circuited in the
body ground.
HINT:
In this case, the A ECU represents the power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU).
(3) Inspect short-circuit in +B of the wire harness between the C ECU and multiplex network body
ECU, and also in the body ground.
Standard:
0 V when short-circuited in +B.
No continuity between each ECU terminal and the body ground when short-circuited in the
body ground.
HINT:
In this case, the C ECU represents the ECM.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
BETWEEN MPX BODY ECU AND A ECU OR C
ECU
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2253
05-2064
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1241
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05DW8-02
BODY ECU SWITCH CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
These DTC notify how the switch works as follows:
If the DTC is not output when operating the switch, switch contact has failed. If the DTC is output when not
operating the switch, it means the switch is ON or stuck. When something wrong is found by this diagnosis,
inspect each switch. Replace the switch if there is a problem or check the body ECU and wire harness.
DTC No.
B1241/41
DTC Detecting Condition
Driver seat belt buckle switch is OFF (fastened) or stuck
Light control switch is ON (TAIL) or stuck
Light control switch is ON (HEAD) or stuck
Trouble Area
Driver seat belt buckle switch
Light control switch
Multiplex network body ECU
Wire harness
HINT:
Please refer to the pages listed below for switch inspection.
For the driver seat belt buckle switch, see page 05-1898 .
For the light control switch, see page 05-1586 .
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2254
05-2065
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1261
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
0523Z-04
ECM (ENGINE ECU) COMMUNICATION
STOP
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
B1261 will be output when the communication between the ECM and multiplex network body ECU stops
for more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
B1261
DTC Detecting Condition
No communication from ECM for more than 10 seconds
Trouble Area
ECM
Wire harness
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2255
05-2066
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
B10
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Engine Room J/B
1
EFI
No.1
5
MPX1
EFI
Relay
6
2
1
2I
5 2B
3
BR
W
P-L
W
4 2B 7 2B
W B-W
IK2 10 IK2 11
4 2F
W
W-B
W
W
ECM
3
E5
1
E5
2
E5
MPX1
BATT
+B
E1
1
13
IK3
F7
FL Block
Assy
*1
E9
1
*2
E7
1
+B2
MREL
E5 8
3
18
E6
MPX2
E6 29
BR
GR
B
GR
GR
W
A
A
IE1 6
J2
J/C
FL MAIN
Y
S20
Sliding Roof
Contorl ECU
Battery
J7
J/C
IL2 1
10
A
MPX1
BR
SB
EE *1
2
ED *
EH
9
MPX+
*1: 2AZ-FE
*2: 3MZ-FE
C12
Combination Meter Assy (Meter ECU)
B78728
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2256
05-2067
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK CONTINUITY OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Check the wire harness between the combination meter assy (meter ECU), ECM and multiplex network body ECU
ECM
E6
E5
Combination Meter Assy (Meter ECU)
Multiplex Network Body ECU
B10
C12
H45688
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2257
05-2068
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(1)
(2)
Disconnect the connectors of the meter assy, ECM and body ECU.
Inspect the continuity between terminals E6-18 (MPX1) of the ECM vehicle’s side connector and
B10-6 (MPX1) of the body ECU vehicle’s side connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
MPX1 (E6-18) ⇔ MPX1 (B10-6)
(equipped with 1MZ-FE)
Continuity
MPX1 (E6-18) ⇔ MPX1 (B10-6)
(equipped with 2AZ-FE)
Continuity
(3)
Inspect the continuity between terminals E6-29 (MPX2) of the ECM vehicle’s side connector and
C12-9 (MPX+) of the meter assy vehicle’s side connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
MPX2 (E6-29) ⇔ MPX+ (C12-9)
(equipped with 1MZ-FE)
Continuity
MPX2 (E6-29) ⇔ MPX+ (C12-9)
(equipped with 2AZ-FE)
Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2
CHECK ECM
(a) Inspect the ECM (power source input).
NOTICE:
Do not disconnect the ECM connector. The inspection should be started from the backside of the
connector.
E7
E9
E8
E5
E6
A53766
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
In/Output
BATT (E5-3) ⇔ Body ground
Input
Constant
Condition
9 - 14 V
+B (E5-1) ⇔ Body ground
Input
Engine stopped, ignition switch ON
9 - 14 V
+B2 (E5-2) ⇔ Body ground
Input
Engine stopped, ignition switch ON
9 - 14 V
NG
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUSE
HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
OR
WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2258
05-2069
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK ECM
(a) Inspect the ECM (body ground).
NOTICE:
Do not disconnect the ECM connector. The inspection should be started from the backside of the
connector.
(1) Inspect the continuity between each terminal of the ECM connector and the body ground.
E7
E6
E9
E8
E5
A53766
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
In/Output
E1 (E9-1 (*1), E7-1 (*2)) ⇔
Body ground
Input
Condition
Constant
Specified Condition
Continuity
(*1) : 2AZ-FE
(*2) : 3MZ-FE
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2259
05-2070
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05240-05
B1262/62 A/C ECU COMMUNICATION STOP
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
B1262/62 will be output when the communication between the air conditioner amplifier assy (A/C ECU) and
multiplex network body ECU stops for more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
B1262/62
DTC Detecting Condition
No communication from A/C ECU for more than 10 seconds
Trouble Area
Air conditioner amplifier assy (A/C ECU)
Wire harness
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2260
05-2071
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
P5
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
MPX1
7
V
IB2 8
SB
W-L
7 4F
Passenger Side J/B
Engine
Room
J/B
BR
2
S31
Short
1 Connector
BR
R
1 2I
10 1G
W
3
F7
FL Block
Assy
5 4A
5 IC3
D.C.C.
ECU-B
4 2A
Instrument Panel
J/B Assy
2 1K
IL2 12
Air conditioner
Amplifier Assy
(A/C ECU)
G
2 A11
1
W
W
FL MAIN
12
A10 +B
MPX+
11
GND A10
W-B
MPX9 A10
G
Center
J/B
12 3J
Center J/B
3J 6
3F 13
1 3E
Battery
W-B
Y
IB
21
MPX-
C11
Combination Meter Assy (Meter ECU)
B78729
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2261
05-2072
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK CONTINUITY OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Inspect the wire harness between the combination meter assy (meter ECU), air conditioner amplifier
assy (A/C ECU) and power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU).
Air Conditioner Amplifier Assy (A/C ECU)
A11
A10
Combination Meter Assy (Meter ECU)
C11
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
P5
B51594
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2262
05-2073
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(1)
(2)
Disconnect the connectors of the air conditioner amplifier, master switch and meter assy.
Inspect the continuity between terminal A10-9 (MPX-) of the air conditioner amplifier vehicle’s
side connector and terminal C11-21 (MPX-) of the meter assy vehicle’s side connector.
Standard: Continuity
(3) Inspect the continuity between terminal A11-2 (MPX+) of the air conditioner amplifier vehicle’s
side connector and terminal P5-7 (MPX1) of the master switch.
Standard: Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2
(a)
CHECK AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
Inspect the air conditioner amplifier assy (A/C ECU) (power source input).
A10
B51596
(1)
(2)
Disconnect the air conditioner amplifier connector A10.
Inspect the voltage between terminal A10-12 (+B) of the vehicle’s side connector and the body
ground.
Standard: 10 - 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUSE
HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
OR
WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2263
05-2074
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
Inspect the air conditioner amplifier assy (A/C ECU) (body ground).
A10
B51837
(1)
(2)
Disconnect the air conditioner amplifier connector A10.
Inspect the continuity between terminal A10-11 (GND) of the vehicle’s side connector and the
body ground.
Standard: Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2264
05-2075
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05241-06
B1269/69 THEFT DETERRENT ECU COMMUNICATION
STOP
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
B1269/69 will be output when the communication between the theft warning ECU assy (theft deterrent ECU)
and multiplex network body ECU stops for more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
B1269/69
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
No communication from theft deterrent ECU for more than 10 seconds
Theft warning ECU assy (theft deterrent ECU)
Wire harness
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2265
05-2076
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
T4
Theft Warning ECU Assy
(Theft Deterrent ECU)
4
IC3
L
Instrument
Panel J/B
10
9
1G
1D
BR
2
IF1
W
J17
J/C
3
+B2
E
P
E
L
P
E
11
IL1
O
2
29
+B1
MPX1
31
IC3
5
W-L
2A
4
2A
5
V
W-B
5 3H
5
3D
13
3F
Center
J/B
ECU-B
Engine Room J/B
SECURITY
D.C.C.
1
2I
W
3
F7
FL Block Assy
3E
3J
1
12
Y
C11 21
MPXCombination
Meter
W-B
G
1
W
FL Main
A10
Air Conditioner
Amplifier Assy
(A/C ECU)
Battery
9
MPX-
IB
H45692
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2266
05-2077
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK CONTINUITY OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Check the wire harness between the combination meter, theft warning ECU assy (theft deterrent ECU)
and airconditioner amplifier assy (A/C ECU).
Theft Warning ECU Assy
(Theft Deterrent ECU)
T4
Air Conditioner
Amplifier Assy
(A/C ECU)
A10
Combination Meter
C11
H45691
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2267
05-2078
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(1)
(2)
Disconnect the connectors of the theft warning ECU, master switch and air conditioner amplifier.
Check the continuity between terminal T4-31 (MPX1) of the theft warning ECU vehicle’s side
connector and terminal C11-21 (MPX-) of the master switch vehicle’s side connector.
(3) Check the continuity between terminal T4-31 (MPX1) of the theft warning ECU vehicle’s side
connector and terminal A10-9 (MPX-) of the air conditioner amplifier vehicle’s side connector.
Standard: Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2
(a)
CHECK THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY
Inspect the theft warning ECU assy (theft deterrent ECU) (power source input).
(1) Disconnect the theft warning ECU connector.
(2) Check the voltage between terminal T4-2 (+B1) and T4-8 (+B2) of the theft warning ECU and
the body ground.
Standard: 10 - 14 V
4
T4
B50657
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUSE
HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
OR
WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2268
05-2079
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY
Inspect the theft warning ECU assy (theft deterrent ECU) (body ground).
(1) Disconnect the theft warning ECU connector.
(2) Check the continuity between terminal T4-29 (E) of the theft warning ECU vehicle’s side connector and the body ground.
Standard: Continuity
T4
B50657
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2269
05-2080
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1271
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05242-04
COMBINATION METER ECU
COMMUNICATION STOP
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
B1271 will be output when the communication between the combination meter assy (meter ECU) and multiplex network body ECU stops for more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
B1271
DTC Detecting Condition
No communication from meter ECU for more than 10 seconds
Trouble Area
Combination meter assy (meter ECU)
Wire harness
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2270
05-2081
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
F7
FL Block Assy
Engine Room J/B
1
2I
D.C.C.
W
W
3
FL Main
1
ECM
DOME
ECU-B
Battery
MPX2
E6 29
3 2A
4 2A
GR
W-L
IC3 5
1 IL2
BR
10 1G
1
Instrument
Panel J/B
SB
Combination Meter
Assy (Meter ECU) 9 C12
2
MPX+
C11 B
1K
L-G
22
E2 C11
12
C11 B1
V
R
W-B
MPX21 C11
3 3D
10 3E
Center J/B
9
3F
1
L-G
Center
J/B
Y
3E
Center
J/B
IL2 11
V
11 4D
12 3J
13 3F
W-B
IB
G
6
4H
V
IK3 12
Air Conditioner
Amplifer Assy
(A/C ECU)
9 A10
MPX-
B78731
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2271
05-2082
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK CONTINUITY OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Inspect the wire harness between the ECM, combination meter assy (meter ECU) and air conditioner
amplifier assy (A/C ECU).
ECM
Combination Meter Assy (Meter ECU)
E6
E5
Air Conditioner Amplifier Assy (A/C ECU)
C12
A10
C11
H45689
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2272
05-2083
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(1)
(2)
Disconnect the connectors of the meter assy, ECM and air conditioner amplifier.
Inspect the continuity between terminal C12-9 (MPX+) of the meter assy vehicle’s side connector and terminal E6-29 (MPX2) of the ECM vehicle’s side connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
MPX+ (C12-9) ⇔ MPX2 (E6-29)
(equipped with 1MZ-FE)
Continuity
MPX+ (C12-9) ⇔ MPX2 (E6-29)
(equipped with 2AZ-FE)
Continuity
(3)
Inspect the continuity between terminal C11-21 (MPX-) of the meter assy vehicle’s side connector and terminal A10-9 (MPX-) of the air conditioner amplifier vehicle’s side connector.
Standard: Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2
(a)
CHECK COMBINATION METER ASSY
Inspect the combination meter assy (meter ECU) (power source input).
C11
B51838
(1) Disconnect the meter assy connector C11.
(2) Inspect the voltage of each terminal of the vehicle’s side connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Condition
Specified Condition
B (C11-2) ⇔ Body ground
Constant
10 - 14 V
B1 (C11-12) ⇔ Body ground
Constant
10 - 14 V
HINT:
If the value is not as specified, there may be a malfunction in the vehicle’s side connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUSE
HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
OR
WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2273
05-2084
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK COMBINATION METER ASSY
Inspect the combination meter assy (meter ECU) (body ground).
C11
B51839
(1)
(2)
Disconnect the meter assy connector C11.
Inspect the continuity between terminal C11-22 (E2) of the vehicle’s side connector and the body
ground.
Standard: Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2274
05-2085
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05243-03
B1273/73 SLIDING ROOF ECU COMMUNICATION
STOP
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
B1273/73 will be output when the communication between the sliding roof drive gear sub-assy (sliding roof
ECU) and the MPX body ECU stops for more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
B1273/73
No communication from sliding roof ECU for more than 10 seconds
Sliding roof drive gear sub-assy (sliding roof ECU)
Wire harness
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2275
05-2086
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
S20
Sliding Roof Drive Gear Sub-assy
(Sliding Roof ECU)
2
IE1
L
1
E
B
MPX1
W-B
7
10
W
IE1 8
Y
W-B
Passenger Side J/ B
1H
S/ROOF
8
IE1 6
5 4D
Instrument
Panel J/B
GR
1
1A
6 4M
B
GR
GR
2
F7
FL Block Assy
1
IL2
FL Main
1
W-B
Instrument
Panel J/B
Assy
W-B
1 4N
W-B
4 1E
29
MPX2
Battery
W-B
IA
C12 Combination Meter
(Meter ECU)
4L
14 1D
SB
9
MPX+
7
IC
E6
ECM
H45687
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2276
05-2087
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK CONTINUITY OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Inspect the wire harness between the ECM, sliding roof drive gear sub-assy (sliding roof ECU) and
combination meter assy (meter ECU).
ECM
E6
Combination Meter Assy (Meter ECU)
Sliding Roof Drive Gear Sub-Assy
(Sliding Roof ECU)
C12
S20
H45690
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2277
05-2088
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(1)
(2)
Disconnect the connectors of the sliding roof ECU, ECM and meter assy.
Inspect the continuity between terminal S20-10 (MPX1) of the sliding roof ECU vehicle’s side
connector and terminal E6-29 (MPX2) of the ECM vehicle’s side connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
MPX1 (S20-10) ⇔ MPX2 (E6-29)
(equipped with 1MZ-FE)
Continuity
MPX1 (S20-10) ⇔ MPX2 (E6-29)
(equipped with 2AZ-FE)
Continuity
(3)
Inspect the continuity between terminal S20-10 (MPX1) of the sliding roof ECU vehicle’s side
connector and terminal C12-9 (MPX+) of the meter assy vehicle’s side connector.
Standard: Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2
CHECK SLIDING ROOF DRIVE GEAR SUB-ASSY
(a)
S20
Inspect the sliding roof drive gear sub-assy (sliding roof
ECU).
(1) Disconnect the sliding roof ECU connector.
(2) Inspect the voltage of each terminal of the vehicle’s
side connector.
B51840
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
B (S20-1) ⇔ Body ground
Condition
Specified Condition
Constant
10 - 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUSE
HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
OR
WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2278
05-2089
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK SLIDING ROOF DRIVE GEAR SUB-ASSY
(a)
S20
Inspect the sliding roof drive gear sub-assy (sliding roof
ECU).
(1) Disconnect the sliding roof ECU connector.
(2) Inspect the voltage of each terminal of the vehicle’s
side connector.
B51841
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
E (S20-7) ⇔ Body ground
Condition
Specified Condition
Constant
Continuity
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE SLIDING ROOF DRIVE GEAR SUB-ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2279
05-2044
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
0523T-05
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
1.
BODY ECU DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
DTC Code
Lamp Code
Diagnostic Item
Diagnostic Result
B1200
Normal
code
Normal
Normal
B1211
11
Power window regulator master switch
assy (door ECU) communication
stop
No communication from door ECU for more than 10 seconds
B1214
-
Communication bus +B battery system
short
Communication circuit and +B battery system short
B1215
-
Communication bus (body ground) short
Communication bus and body ground short
B1241
41
Body ECU switch circuit diagnosis
Switch is ON or stuck
B1261
-
ECM communication stop
No communication from ECM for more than 10 seconds
B1262
62
Airconditioner amplifier assy (A/C ECU)
communication stop
No communication from A/C ECU for more than 10 seconds
B1269
69
Theft warning ECU assy (theft deterrent
ECU) communication stop
No communication from theft warning ECU for more than 10 seconds
B1271
-
Combination meter assy (meter ECU)
communication stop
No communication from meter ECU for more than 10 seconds
B1273
73
Sliding roof drive gear sub-assy (sliding
roof ECU) communication stop
No communication from sliding roof ECU for more then 10 seconds
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2234
05-2040
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
0523R-05
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
2
SYMPTOM CHECK
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF LARGE-SCALE MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)
(a)
Check that there is no abnormality in the communication system by inspecting the communication
function of the multiplex communication system with the hand-held tester.
(1) (ECU communication stop, communication line abnormal) With code output, proceed to A.
(2) (ECU communication stop, communication line abnormal) Without code output, proceed to B.
B
GO TO SECTION OF EACH SYSTEM
A
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK (See page 05-2044 )
Check a DTC and note it if a code is output.
Delete the DTC.
Check if the DTC will be output once again, when the problem symptom is simulated based on the
noted code.
(1) When no code is output (symptom check and simulation is possible), proceed to A.
(2) When no code is output (symptom check and simulation is impossible), proceed to B.
(3) When the code is output, proceed to C.
B
GO TO PROBLEM SIMULATION
(See page 01-26 )
C
Go to step 7
A
5
(a)
(b)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (See page 05-2050 )
Without applicable symptoms, proceed to A.
With applicable symptoms, proceed to B.
B
Go to step 7
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2230
05-2041
DIAGNOSTICS
6
(a)
(b)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
PERFORM TROUBLESHOOTING IN THE FOLLOWING METHOD, DEPENDING ON
MALFUNCTION SYMPTOM
Pre-check (See page 05-2042 )
Terminals of ECU (See page 05-2046 )
7
ADJUSTMENT, REPAIR OR REPLACEMENT
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2231
05-2045
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
0523U-04
LOCATION
Sliding Roof Drive Gear Sub-Assy (Sliding Roof ECU)
Theft Warning ECU Assy
(Theft Deterrent ECU)
ECM
Combination Meter Assy (Meter ECU)
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
Airconditioner Amplifier Assy
(A/C ECU)
B51250
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2235
05-2042
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
0523S-03
PRE-CHECK
1.
(a)
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)
The BEAN communication line is used for the body, meters and air conditioning controls. Since the
line is loop-shaped, the communication can be kept by the line that is not open even if a part of the
line becomes open for some reasons. In case that the line becomes short (bus-down) for some reasons, however, all the BEAN communication will be impossible and some DTC will be output.
HINT:
When a bus-down occurs, the communication from the related ECU will stop. Therefore, an outputs of a
DTC will be impossible. So, perform a DTC (SAE code) inspection with the hand-held tester.
2.
COMMUNICATION FUNCTION INSPECTION
(a) Inspect the battery positive voltage.
Standard: 10 - 14 V
(b) Perform a DTC check of the body ECU by connecting the hand-held tester to the DLC3 and turning
the ignition switch ON.
(1) Check that the DTCs of the ECU unconnected and also a short-circuit in the communication bus
are not output.
3.
INSPECT OUTPUT OF DTC BY DOOR OPEN INDICATOR
(a) Inspect the battery positive voltage.
Standard: 10 - 14 V (when engine stopped)
(b) Check the DTC output.
NOTICE:
No abnormality exists in all the following items; door open indicator LED, wire harness, courtesy
lamp switch’s contact condition, multiplex network body ECU, etc.
(1) Check that the door open indicator will be on when any of the doors is opened.
HINT:
In case that the indicator will not be on, the following problems are possible reasons; door open indicator
LED defective, wire harness short, courtesy light switch’s contact condition defective, multiplex network
body ECU defective, etc.
(2)
Using SST (diagnosis check wire), make a shortcircuit between terminals TC (13) and CG (4) of the
DLC3 connector.
SST 09843-18040
NOTICE:
Do not make a short-circuit in any other positions.
DLC3
TC
CG
B61051
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2232
05-2043
DIAGNOSTICS
(3)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Turn the ignition (starter) switch ON and read the number of blinks of the door open indicator.
HINT:
When 2 or more codes are output simultaneously, the display will be started from the smallest numbered
code.
Normal output (DTC not output)
Repeated
DTCs 11 and 41 output
ON
OFF
1.0 sec.
0.5 sec.
2.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
4.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
B51822
(4)
When the DTC of the ECU unconnected is displayed, perform an inspection depending on the
troubleshooting.
HINT:
4.
(a)
(b)
When the communication bus is defective, the door open indicator in the meter will not be on. Therefore
no DTC will be output.
When other DTCs are output, refer to the DTC chart and applicable section.
When no normal output is output even in the normal condition, problems, such as a short-circuit between terminals TC and CG, meter fuses defective, etc., may exist.
When the door open indicator is always on, the wire harness might be short-circuited.
INSPECT OUTPUT OF DTC WITH HAND-HELD TESTER
Inspect the battery positive voltage.
Standard: 10 - 14 V
Inspect the DTC monitor code output.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 and turn the ignition (starter) switch ON, then check
the DTC.
HINT:
When the DTC check is impossible, check the following items.
ECU data monitor is possible (multiplex network body ECU is defective).
The display shows a communication error (refer to the new diagnostic system and operations when
an error occurred). (See page 01-26 )
(2) When the display shows DTCs that the ECU is unconnected and the communication bus is defective, perform an inspection depending on the troubleshooting.
HINT:
When other DTCs are output, refer to the DTC chart and applicable section.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2233
05-2050
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
0523W-04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
1.
TROUBLESHOOTING FOR EACH PROBLEM SYMPTOM
NOTICE:
Confirm the problem symptom and make an inspection depending on the applicable flow chart.
Problem Symptom
Suspected Area
See Page
B1211/11 (no communication from driver door ECU for more than
10 seconds)
1. Power window regulator master switch assembly
2. Wire harness
05-2051
05-2051
B1214 (short in communication circuit and +B power source system)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Power window regulator master switch assembly
ECM
Air conditioning amplifier assembly
Combination meter assembly
Theft warning ECU
Sliding roof drive gear
Wire harness
MPX body ECU
05-2056
05-2056
05-2056
05-2056
05-2056
05-2056
05-2056
05-2056
B1215 (short in communication circuit and body ground)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Power window regulator master switch assembly
ECM
Air conditioning amplifier assembly
Combination meter assembly
Theft warning ECU
Sliding roof drive gear
Wire harness
MPX body ECU
05-2056
05-2056
05-2056
05-2056
05-2056
05-2056
05-2056
05-2056
B1261 (no communication from ECM for more than 10 seconds)
1. ECM
2. Wire harness
05-2065
05-2065
B1262/62 (no communication from A/C ECU for more than 10
seconds)
1. Air conditioning amplifier assembly
2. Wire harness
05-2070
05-2070
B1269/69 (no communication from theft deterrent ECU for more
than 10 seconds)
1. Theft warning ECU
2. Wire harness
05-2075
05-2075
B1271 (no communication from combination meter ECU for more
than 10 seconds)
1. Combination meter assembly
2. Wire harness
05-2080
05-2080
B1273/73 (no communication from sliding roof control ECU for
more than 10 seconds)
1. Sliding roof drive gear
2. Wire harness
05-2085
05-2085
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2240
05-2046
DIAGNOSTICS
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
0523V-05
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
(a)
MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
Check the body ECU.
(1) Disconnect the body ECU connectors B9 and B12.
(2) Check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the vehicle’s side connectors.
B11
B12
B9
B10
B51823
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
GND1 (B12-7) ⇔ Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Condition
Continuity
Specified Condition
GND2 (B9-2) ⇔ Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Continuity
BECU (B12-9) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
G ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
BDR1 (B12-4) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
B ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
HINT:
If the value is not as specified, the vehicle’s side may be defective.
2.
P5
(a)
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH
ASSY (DOOR ECU)
Check the master switch.
(1) Disconnect the master switch connector.
(2) Check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of
the vehicle’s side connector.
B51239
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
GND (P5-2) ⇔
Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Continuity
CPUB (P5-9) ⇔
GND (P5-2)
L ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
BDR (P5-10) ⇔
GND (P5-2)
G ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
HINT:
If the value is not as specified, the vehicle’s side may be defective.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2236
05-2047
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
(a)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
COMBINATION METER ASSY (METER ECU)
Check the meter.
(1) Disconnect the meter connector C11.
(2) Check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the vehicle’s side connector.
C12
C11
B51824
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
E2 (C11-22) ⇔ Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Condition
Continuity
Specified Condition
B (C11-2) ⇔ E2 (C11-22)
LG ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
B2 (C11-12) ⇔ E2 (C11-22)
V ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
HINT:
If the value is not as specified, the vehicle’s side may be defective.
4.
AIR CONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY (A/C ECU)
(a) Check the air conditioner amplifier.
(1) Disconnect the air conditioner amplifier connector A10.
(2) Check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the vehicle’s side connector.
A11
A10
B51825
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
GND (A10-11) ⇔ Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Condition
Continuity
Specified Condition
+B (A10-12) ⇔ GND (A10-11)
W ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
HINT:
If the value is not as specified, the vehicle’s side may be defective.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2237
05-2048
DIAGNOSTICS
5.
(a)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
THEFT WARNING ECU ASSY (THEFT DETERRENT ECU)
Check the theft warning ECU.
(1) Disconnect the connector.
(2) Check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the vehicle’s side connector.
T4
B50657
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
E (T4-29) ⇔ Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Condition
Continuity
Specified Condition
+B1 (T4-2) ⇔ E (T4-29)
O ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
+B2 (T4-3) ⇔ E (T4-29)
L ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
6.
(a)
ECM
Inspect the ECM operation.
(1) Check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the vehicle’s side connectors.
NOTICE:
The inspection should be started from the back side of the connector with the ECM connector
being connected.
Before the measurement, check the power source voltage (10 - 14 V when IG ON) and body
ground (5 Ω or less between each ground terminal and the engine body, when IG OFF).
E7
E9
E8
E6
E5
A53766
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
BATT (E5-3) ⇔ E1 (E9-1(*1))
BR ⇔ BR
Constant
9 - 14 V
+B (E5-1) ⇔ E1 (E7-1(*2))
W ⇔ BR
Engine stopped, ignition switch ON
9 - 14 V
+B2 (E5-2) ⇔ E1 (E9-1(*1), E7-1(*2))
W ⇔ BR
Engine stopped, ignition switch ON
9 - 14 V
E1
⇔ Body ground
E7 (E7-1)*2 ⇔ Body ground
BR ⇔ -
Continuity
Constant
(E9-1)*1
Condition
Specified Condition
*1:2AZ-FE
*2:3MZ-FE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2238
05-2049
DIAGNOSTICS
7.
S20
(a)
-
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
SLIDING ROOF DRIVE GEAR SUB-ASSY (SLIDING
ROOF ECU)
Check the sliding roof ECU.
(1) Disconnect the sliding roof ECU connector.
(2) Check the voltage or continuity between each terminal of the vehicle’s side connectors.
B51247
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
E (S20-7) ⇔ Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Condition
Continuity
Specified Condition
B (S20-1) ⇔ E (S20-7)
L ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2239
05-1912
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523I-02
B1221/21 POWER WINDOW SWITCH CIRCUIT ON
DRIVER DOOR
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when any switch of the power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU) is ON.
DTC No.
B1221/21
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Any switch of the power window regulator master switch is
ON
Power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSY
Check if code B1221/21 will disappear but only B1211/11 (communication stop) will be output when
the master switch connector is disconnected.
(1) B1221/21 code output, proceed to A.
(2) B1211/11 code output, proceed to B.
B
REPLACE POWER WINDOW
MASTER SWITCH ASSY
REGULATOR
A
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2102
05-1913
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523H-03
DTC
B1231/31 JAM PROTECTION LIMIT SWITCH CIRCUIT
ON DRIVER DOOR
DTC
B1232/32 JAM PROTECTION PULSE SWITCH CIRCUIT
ON DRIVER DOOR
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when the power window regulator motor assy malfunctions.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
B1231/31
Open in power window regulator motor assy LH limit switch
system
Power window regulator motor assy LH
Wire harness
Trouble Area
B1232/32
Open or short in power window regulator motor assy LH
pulse sensor system
Power window regulator motor assy LH
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
P5
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
P6
Power Window Regulator
Motor Assy Front LH
PLS
6
W
15
LMT
2
O
5
E
3
R
13
PLS
LMT
SGND
B60591
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2103
05-1914
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(a)
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
(b)
Power Window Regulator
Motor Assy LH
Disconnect the connectors of the power window regulator
master switch assy and power window regulator motor
assy LH.
Check the continuity between the master switch and regulator motor.
Standard:
Item
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Master switch ⇔ Regulator motor
Specified Condition
Limit switch
LMT (5) ⇔ LMT (2)
SGND (13) ⇔ E (3)
Continuity
Pulse sensor
PLS (15) ⇔ PLS (6)
SGND (13) ⇔ E (3)
Continuity
NG
B51843
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY LH (DRIVER SIDE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2104
05-1929
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523N-06
REMOTE OPERATION VIA MASTER SWITCH IS IMPOSSIBLE IN
THE OTHER DOOR (OPERATION VIA EACH DOOR SWITCH IS
POSSIBLE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is ON, the master switch (door ECU) sends a remote switch signal for the other seats
multiply to the body ECU, then the body ECU drives the power window motor for the other seats.
NOTICE:
The power window system has a function with a large-scale multiplex communications. First of all,
inspect the communication function depending on the ”how to proceed with troubleshooting”, and
check that there is no abnormality in the communication system. Then finally proceed with the troubleshooting.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2119
05-1930
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
P5
Power Window Regulator Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
MPX1
MPX2
8
7
Communication Line
6 B10 10 B9
MPX2
MPX1
7
GND1 B12
Multiplex Network Body ECU
PU
21 B10
PD
20 B10
RLD
13 B11
RLU
14 B11
RRU
9 B11
LG
W
O
RRD
8 B11
BR
W-B
Passenger
Side J/B
11 4H
B
11 IN2
GR
4 IN2
Y
LG
4
5
17 IA1
5 IA1
R
P
4 BB1
9 BB1
L-O
7 IO2
GR
R
L-O
5
4
1
1
1
W-B
2 IN1
1
4N
5
P12
SU
SD
Power Window Regulator
Switch Assy Rear (Rear RH)
E
4L
LG-B
P11
SU
SD
Power Window Regulator
Switch Assy Rear (Rear LH)
E
7
9 BC1
4 BC1
LG-B
4
P10
SU
SD
Power Window Regulator Switch
Assy (Passenger Side)
16 IO2
E
W-B
12 BB1
W-B
12 BC1
W-B
10 4L
Passenger Side J/B
1 4N
W-B
7
W-B
W-B
W-B
W-B
4L
W-B
IC
BA
BB
IC
B78735
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2120
05-1931
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK HAND-HELD TESTER
Monitor code
(1) Using the hand-held tester, inspect the monitor code of the door ECU.
HINT:
The monitor code shows the switch condition when a DTC is output.
When a monitor code is indicated while the switch is not operated, the switch is detected in being stuck.
When a monitor code is not indicated while the switch is operated, it is detected that the switch contact
condition is bad.
DTC Code
Item
B1221/21
Driver’s side switch 1 (operating)
Monitor Item
Any switch of the power window regulator master switch is ON
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2121
05-1932
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
(a)
Inspect the output of the body ECU.
(1) Inspect the voltage between terminal 7 (GND1) and each terminal of the door which body ECU
is inoperative.
B12
B9
B10
B11
B51823
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Condition
Specified Condition
PU (B10-21) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
Ignition switch ON,
master switch passenger side switch OFF → UP (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
PD (B10-20) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
Ignition switch ON,
master switch passenger side switch OFF → DOWN (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
RRU (B11-9) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
Ignition switch ON,
master switch rear RH side switch OFF → UP (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
RRD (B11-8) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
Ignition switch ON,
master switch rear RH side switch OFF → DOWN (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
RLU (B11-14) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
Ignition switch ON,
master switch rear LH side switch OFF → UP (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
RLD (B11-13) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
Ignition switch ON,
master switch rear LH side switch OFF → DOWN (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
HINT:
When an output to the passenger door is normal, proceed to OK-A.
When outputs to both rear doors are normal, proceed to OK-B.
When an output to either of the passenger door and both rear doors are abnormal, proceed to NG.
OK-B
NG
Go to step 4
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
OK-A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2122
05-1933
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSY (PASSENGER SIDE)
(a)
Check the continuity.
(1) Check the continuity between each terminal of the
connectors.
B31305
Standard:
Switch Operation
4
Measuring Condition
Specified Condition
Not operated
Terminal 4 ⇔ Terminal 1
Continuity
Not operated
Terminal 5 ⇔ Terminal 1
Continuity
OK
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
NG
REPLACE POWER
SWITCH ASSY
HARNESS
WINDOW
AND
REGULATOR
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSY REAR (REAR RH AND LH)
(a)
Check the continuity.
(1) Check the continuity between each terminal of the
connectors.
B31305
Standard:
Switch Operation
Measuring Condition
Specified Condition
Not operated
Terminal 4 ⇔ Terminal 1
Continuity
Not operated
Terminal 5 ⇔ Terminal 1
Continuity
OK
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW
SWITCH ASSY REAR
AND
REGULATOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2123
05-1920
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523Q-04
WINDOWS CANNOT BE OPERATED VIA REGULATOR SWITCH AT
EACH SEAT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
With the ignition switch ON and the window lock switch at NORMAL (except driver side), each regulator
switch drives each power window motor.
NOTICE:
The power window system has a function with a large-scale body multiplex communications. First
of all, inspect the communication function depending on the ”how to proceed with troubleshooting”,
and check that there is no abnormality in the communication system. Then finally proceed with the
troubleshooting.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2110
05-1921
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
P10
Power Window Regulator Switch Assy
(Passenger Side)
3
IN1
BR
G
7
V
4
7
4L
Regulator Motor Assy
10
4L
GR
2
IN1
W-B
W-B
GR
Front RH
5
1 4N
IC
U
Power Window
Passenger Side
J/B
W-B
3
P7
+B
11
IA1
GR
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
6
W-B
1
D
E
P11
Power Window
Regulator Switch Assy Rear (Rear LH)
1
L-W
BB1
+B
7
R
D FR DOOR
12
1D
P RR DOOR
3
1H
D RR DOOR
1A
5
4
G
BA
1
L
10
IO1
6
12
W-B
BB1
W-B
8
1D
3
P8
Power Window Regulator
Motor Assy Rear LH
P
1
To Battery
D
E
P12
Power Window
Regulator Switch Assy Rear (Rear RH)
1
L-W
+B
BC1
7
R
5
U
3
P9
Power Window Regulator
Motor Assy Rear RH
4
G
W-B
6
12
W-B
BC1
1
U
D
E
BB
B78734
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2111
05-1922
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK FUSE
Check whether the regulator switch fuses D FR DOOR 25 A, P RR DOOR 20 A and D RR DOOR 20
A of inoperative seats are normal.
HINT:
If
If
If
If
If
the
the
the
the
the
fuse for the passenger side door is normal, proceed to OK-A.
fuse for the rear RH and LH doors is normal, proceed to OK-B.
fuse for the passenger side door is defective, proceed to NG-A.
fuse for the rear RH door is defective, proceed to NG-B.
fuse for the rear LH door is defective, proceed to NG-C.
OK-B
Go to step 6
NG-A
REPLACE FUSE (D FR DOOR 25 A)
NG-B
REPLACE FUSE (P RR DOOR 20 A)
NG-B
REPLACE FUSE (D RR DOOR 20 A)
OK-A
2
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSY (PASSENGER SIDE)
(a)
8 7 6 5 4
Inspect the power source voltage.
(1) Disconnect the regulator switch connector.
(2) Check the voltage between terminal 7 (B) of the regulator switch vehicle’s side connector and the body
ground.
Standard: 10 - 14 V with ignition switch ON
NG
B51844
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSY (PASSENGER SIDE)
(a)
8 7 6 5 4
Inspect the GND.
(1) Disconnect the regulator switch connector.
(2) Check the continuity between terminal 1 (E) of the
regulator switch vehicle’s side connector and the
body ground.
Standard: Continuity (constant)
NG
B51845
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2112
05-1923
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY RH (PASSENGER SIDE)
(a)
8 7 6 5 4
B51846
Inspect the motor operation.
(1) Disconnect the regulator switch connector.
(2) Inspect the door glass operation when the battery
voltage is applied between terminals 3 (U) and 6 (D)
of the regulator switch vehicle’s side connector.
Standard:
Measuring Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive - Terminal 3 (U)
Battery negative - Terminal 6 (D)
Upward
Battery positive - Terminal 6 (D)
Battery negative - Terminal 3 (U)
Downward
OK
REPLACE POWER
SWITCH ASSY
WINDOW
Author:
Date:
REGULATOR
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
2113
05-1924
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY RH (PASSENGER SIDE)
(a)
Driving Axis
Counterclockwise
Inspect the operation of the front LH power window regulator motor assembly.
(1) Check that the motor operates smoothly when the
battery voltage is applied to each terminal of the
connector.
Standard:
Measuring Condition
Clockwise
B51847
Operational Direction
Battery positive - Terminal 4
Battery negative - Terminal 5
Clockwise rotation toward driving axis
Battery positive - Terminal 5
Battery negative - Terminal 4
Counterclockwise rotation toward driving
axis
(b) Inspect the PTC operation inside the power window regulator motor.
NOTICE:
The inspection should be performed with the power window regulator and door glass installed to the
vehicle.
(1) Set a DC 400 A probe of the electrical tester in the wire harness of terminal 1 or 2.
NOTICE:
Match the arrow mark of the probe with the current direction.
(2) Set the door glass in the fully closed position.
(3) When 60 seconds have elapsed after the door glass is fully closed, check now long the current
takes to charge, from approximately 16 - 34 A into 1 A or less, when the power window switch
is turned UP once again.
Standard: Approximately 4 - 90 seconds
(4) When approximately 60 seconds have elapsed after the inspection of the current cut-off, check
that the door glass goes down when the power window regulator switch is turned DOWN.
6
OK
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
NG
REPLACE POWER
MOTOR ASSY RH
HARNESS
WINDOW
AND
REGULATOR
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSY REAR (REAR RH AND LH)
(a)
8 7 6 5 4
B51844
Inspect the power source voltage.
(1) Disconnect the regulator switch connector.
(2) Check the voltage between terminal 7 (+B) of the
regulator switch vehicle’s side connector and the
body ground.
Standard: 10 - 14 V with ignition switch ON
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2114
05-1925
DIAGNOSTICS
7
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSY REAR (REAR RH AND LH)
(a)
8 7 6 5 4
B51845
8
-
Inspect the GND.
(1) Disconnect the regulator switch connector.
(2) Check the continuity between terminal 1 (E) of the
regulator switch vehicle’s side connector and the
body ground.
Standard: Continuity (constant)
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OK-A
Go to step 8 (In case Rear RH side)
OK-B
Go to step 10 (In case Rear LH side)
AND
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY RH (REAR RH)
(a)
8 7 6 5 4
B51846
Inspect the motor operation.
(1) Disconnect the regulator switch connector.
(2) Inspect the door glass operation when the battery
voltage is applied between terminals 3 (U) and 6 (D)
of the regulator switch vehicle’s side connector.
Standard:
Measuring condition
Operational direction
Battery positive - Terminal 3 (U)
Battery negative - Terminal 6 (D)
Upward
Battery positive - Terminal 6 (D)
Battery negative - Terminal 3 (U)
Downward
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW
SWITCH ASSY REAR
REGULATOR
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2115
05-1926
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY RH (REAR RH)
(a)
Driving Axis
Clockwise
Inspect the operation of the power window regulator motor assy RH (Rear RH side).
(1) Check that the motor operates smoothly when the
battery voltage is applied to each terminal of the
connector.
Standard:
Measuring Condition
Counterclockwise
B51848
Operational Direction
Battery positive - Terminal 5
Battery negative - Terminal 4
Clockwise rotation toward driving axis
Battery positive - Terminal 4
Battery negative - Terminal 5
Counterclockwise rotation toward driving
axis
(b) Inspect the PTC operation inside the power window regulator motor.
NOTICE:
The inspection should be performed with the power window regulator and door glass installed to the
vehicle.
(1) Set a DC 400 A probe of the electrical tester in the wire harness of terminal 1 or 2.
NOTICE:
Match the arrow mark of the probe with the current direction.
(2) Set the door glass in the fully closed position.
(3) When 60 seconds have elapsed after the door glass is fully closed, check now long the current
takes to charge, from approximately 16 - 34 A into 1 A or less, when the power window switch
is turned UP once again.
Standard: Approximately 4 - 90 seconds
(4) When approximately 60 seconds have elapsed after the inspection of the current cut-off, check
that the door glass goes down when the power window regulator switch is turned DOWN.
OK
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
NG
REPLACE POWER
MOTOR ASSY RH
HARNESS
WINDOW
AND
REGULATOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2116
05-1927
DIAGNOSTICS
10
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY LH (REAR LH)
(a)
8 7 6 5 4
B51846
Inspect the motor operation.
(1) Disconnect the regulator switch connector.
(2) Inspect the door glass operation when the battery
voltage is applied between terminals 3 (U) and 6 (D)
of the regulator switch vehicle’s side connector.
Standard:
Measuring condition
Operational direction
Battery positive - Terminal 3 (U)
Battery negative - Terminal 6 (D)
Upward
Battery positive - Terminal 6 (D)
Battery negative - Terminal 3 (U)
Downward
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW
SWITCH ASSY REAR
REGULATOR
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2117
05-1928
DIAGNOSTICS
11
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY LH (REAR LH)
(a)
Driving Axis
Counterclockwise
Clockwise
B51849
Inspect the operation of the power window regulator motor assy LH (Rear LH side).
(1) Check that the motor operates smoothly when the
battery voltage is applied to each terminal of the
connector.
Standard:
Measuring condition
Operational direction
Battery positive - Terminal 4
Battery negative - Terminal 5
Clockwise rotation toward driving axis
Battery positive - Terminal 5
Battery negative - Terminal 4
Counterclockwise rotation toward driving axis
(b) Inspect the PTC operation inside the power window regulator motor.
NOTICE:
The inspection should be performed with the power window regulator and door glass installed to the
vehicle.
(1) Set a DC 400 A probe of the electrical tester in the wire harness of terminal 1 or 2.
NOTICE:
Match the arrow mark of the probe with the current direction.
(2) Set the door glass in the fully closed position.
(3) When 60 seconds have elapsed after the door glass is fully closed, check now long the current
takes to charge, from approximately 16 - 34 A into 1 A or less, when the power window switch
is turned UP once again.
Standard: Approximately 4 - 90 seconds
(4) When approximately 60 seconds have elapsed after the inspection of the current cut-off, check
that the door glass goes down when the power window regulator switch is turned DOWN.
NG
REPLACE POWER
MOTOR ASSY LH
WINDOW
REGULATOR
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2118
05-1915
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523O-03
DRIVER POWER WINDOW DOES NOT OPERATE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU) controls the driver side power window by itself
and drives the driver side power window motor.
NOTICE:
The power window system has a function with a large-scale multiplex communication. First of all,
inspect the communication function depending on ”how to proceed with troubleshooting” and confirm that the communication system has no abnormality. Then finally perform the troubleshooting.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2105
05-1916
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
P5
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
10
1G
To
Battery
G
7
1C
IG1
3
1D
BR
2
IB2
L
9
1
1D
W
3
IB2
Y
20
4
I15
Ignition
Switch
Assy
IG1
P FR DOOR
6
1K
Y
8
IL1
3
IB1
V
G
10
CPUB
SIG
BDR
AM1
2
W
6
1C
AM1
2
1
To
Battery
1
1A
P6
Power Window
Regulator Motor Assy Front LH
V
U
4
D
1
GR
5
11
2
UP
DN
GND
W-B
2 IB1
W-B
8
4L
7
4L
Passenger Side J/B
1 4N
W-B
W-B
IC
B78733
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2106
05-1917
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK FUSE
Check if the P FR DOOR 20 A, ECU B 7.5 A and IG1 7.5 A fuses are normal.
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSY
(a)
Check the power source voltage.
(1) Disconnect the master switch connector.
(2) Check the voltage of each terminal of the vehicle’s
side connector of the master switch.
B51850
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Condition
Specified Condition
CPUB (9) ⇔ Body ground
Constant
10 - 14 V
BDR (10) ⇔ Body ground
Constant
10 - 14 V
SIG (20) ⇔ Body ground
Ignition switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 - 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSY
(a)
B51851
Check the GND.
(1) Disconnect the master switch connector.
(2) Check the continuity between terminal 2 (GND) of
the vehicle’s side connector of the master switch
and the body ground.
Standard: Continuity (constant)
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2107
05-1918
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY LH (DRIVER’S SIDE)
(a)
(b)
B51852
Disconnect the master switch connector.
Inspect the door glass operation when the battery voltage
is applied between terminals 1 (UP) and 11 (DN) of the vehicle’s side connector of the master switch.
Standard:
Measuring Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive - Terminal 1 (UP)
Battery negative - Terminal 11 (DN)
Upward
Battery positive - Terminal 11 (DN)
Battery negative - Terminal 1 (UP)
Downward
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW
MASTER SWITCH ASSY
REGULATOR
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2108
05-1919
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY LH (DRIVER SIDE)
(a) Inspect the power window regulator motor assy LH (Driver side) operation.
NOTICE:
Do not apply the battery voltage, because the pulse sensor and limit switch could be damaged
if the battery voltage is applied to terminals 2, 3 and 6 of the power window regulator motor connector.
Be sure to reset the power window regulator motor (initial position setting of limit switch) when
the driver’s side power window regulator motor is installed to the regulator.
(1) Check that the motor operates smoothly when the
Driving Axis
battery positive voltage is applied to each terminal
of the connector.
Standard:
Measuring Condition
Counterclockwise
Clockwise
Operational Direction
Battery positive - Terminal 5
Battery negative - Terminal 4
Clockwise
Battery positive - Terminal 4
Battery negative - Terminal 5
Counterclockwise
B51847
(b) Inspect the PTC operation inside the power window regulator motor.
NOTICE:
The inspection should be performed with the power window regulator and door glass installed to the
vehicle.
(1) Set a DC 400 A probe of the electrical tester in the wire harness of terminal 4 or 5.
NOTICE:
Match the arrow mark of the probe with the current direction.
(2) Set the door glass in the fully closed position.
(3) When 60 seconds have elapsed after the door glass is fully closed, check now long the current
takes to charge, from approximately 16 - 34 A into 1 A or less, when the power window switch
is turned UP once again.
Standard: Approximately 4 - 90 seconds
(4) When approximately 60 seconds have elapsed after the inspection of the current cut-off, check
that the door glass goes down when the power window regulator switch is turned DOWN.
NG
REPLACE POWER
MOTOR ASSY LH
WINDOW
REGULATOR
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2109
05-1904
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523F-02
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
Registration No.
Registration Year
Customer’s Name
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought in
/
/
Date Problem First Occurred
/
Constant
Once only
Weather
Fine Cloudy
Various/Others
Outdoor
Temperature
Hot
Warm
Cold (Approx.
Frequency Problem Occurs
Weather
Conditions
When Problem
Occurred
km
miles
Odometer Reading
Diagnosis code is output
/
Sometimes (
times per
Rainy
Snowy
Cool
C (
F))
B1221/21
B1231/31
day, month)
B1232/32
AUTO UP/AUTO DOWN is impossible
Operation interlocked with key is impossible
Malfunction
Symptoms
Operation after key-OFF is impossible
Remote operation by the master switch is impossible in a switch
Passenger Side
Rear RH Side
Rear LH Side
Operation by a switch of each seat is impossible in a switch
Passenger Side
Condition when
recovered normal
Condition when
problem occurred
IG ON
Yes No
Rear RH Side
Engine Started
IG OFF ON
(
Rear LH Side
(
) Switch operated
) Switch operated
Others (
)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2094
05-1908
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523J-02
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
1.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
Door ECU (driver side)
DTC Code
Item
Diagnosis
B1231/31
Driver side jam protection limit switch malfunctions
Power window regulator motor assy RH open in limit switch
system
B1232/32
Driver side jam protection sensor malfunctions
Power window regulator motor assy RH open or short in pulse
sensor system
2.
MONITOR CODE
HINT:
The monitor code shows the switch condition when a DTC is output.
When a monitor code is indicated while the switch is not operated, the switch is detected in being stuck.
When a monitor code is not indicated while the switch is operated, it is detected that the switch contact
condition is bad.
DTC Code
B1221/21
Item
Driver side switch 1 (operating)
Monitor Item
Any switch of the power window regulator master switch is ON
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2098
05-1902
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523E-02
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK AND SYMPTOM CHECK
(See page 05-1904 )
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF LARGE-SCALE MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)
(a)
Check that there is no abnormality in the communication system by inspecting the communication
function of the multiplex communication system with the hand-held tester.
(1) (ECU unconnected, communication line abnormal) Without code output, proceed to A.
(2) (ECU unconnected, communication line abnormal) With code output, proceed to B.
B
GO TO MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SECTION (See page 05-2044 )
A
4
(a)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK (See page 05-1908 )
Check the diagnostic trouble code.
(1) Without code output, proceed to A.
(2) With code output, proceed to B.
B
Go to step 7
A
5
(a)
(b)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (See page 05-191 1)
Without applicable symptoms, proceed to A.
With applicable symptoms, proceed to B.
B
Go to step 7
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2092
05-1903
DIAGNOSTICS
6
(a)
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
PERFORM TROUBLESHOOTING IN THE FOLLOWING METHOD, DEPENDING ON
MALFUNCTION SYMPTOM
Pre-check (See page 05-1905 )
(1) Check with hand-held tester (ECU data monitor).
(2) Check with hand-held tester (Active test).
Terminals of ECU (See page 05-1909 )
(b)
7
ADJUSTMENT, REPAIR OR REPLACEMENT
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2093
05-1907
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523K-02
LOCATION
Un-lock Warning Switch Assy
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch Assy (Door ECU)
Power Window Regulator Motor
Assy RH
Power Window Regulator Switch Assy
Front Door Window Regulator
Sub-assy RH
Power Window Regulator Motor Assy RH
Rear Door Window
Regulator Sub-assy RH
Power Window Regulator
Motor Assy LH
Front Door Window
Regulator Sub-assy LH
Power Window Regulator
Switch Assy Rear
Power Window Regulator
Switch Assy Rear
Front Door Courtesy Lamp
Switch Assy
Rear Door Window Regulator
Sub-assy LH
Power Window Regulator
Motor Assy LH
B51238
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2097
05-1901
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523D-02
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
NOTICES OF INSPECTION WITH REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION PROCEDURES
Before performing operations related to the front door lock assy RH and door lock cylinder, disconnect
the battery terminal or the connectors of the power window regulator master switch assy.
CAUTION:
If the operation is performed with the connectors being connected, the door control switch (interlocked with key) inside the door lock might be unexpectedly actuated, which results in injury.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2091
05-1905
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523G-02
PRE-CHECK
1.
POWER WINDOW OPERATION MODE
HINT:
The initial condition that the customizing function by the hand-held tester is not chosen is shown.
Standard:
Power window operation
Ignition switch ON
Ignition switch OFF
Operative after key-OFF
Ignition switch OFF
Inoperative after key-OFF
Manual UP
Operative
Jam protection function operative
Inoperative
Manual DOWN
Operative
Operative
Inoperative
Jam protection function operative
Jam protection function operative
Inoperative
Operative
Operative
Inoperative
UP operation interlocked with key
Inoperative
Jam protection function operative
Jam protection function operative
DOWN operation interlocked
with key
Inoperative
Operative
Operative
AUTO UP
AUTO DOWN
2.
(a)
POWER WINDOW FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
When an abnormality is detected in the limit switch and pulse sensor for operating the jam protection
function (DTC: B1231/31, B1232/32), the following power window operations will be prohibited by the
fail-safe function.
Standard:
Power window operation
Ignition switch ON
Ignition switch OFF
Operative after key-OFF
Ignition switch OFF
Inoperative after key-OFF
Manual UP
Operative
Operation prohibited
-
Manual DOWN
Operative
Operation prohibited
-
AUTO UP
Operation prohibited
Operation prohibited
-
AUTO DOWN
Operation prohibited
Operation prohibited
-
UP operation interlocked with key
-
Operation prohibited
Operation prohibited
DOWN operation interlocked
with key
-
Operation prohibited
Operation prohibited
HINT:
In case of normal limit switch, the prohibition (fail-safe function) will be cancelled by fully opening the door
glass that is fully closed by the manual operation, then AUTO operations will be possible.
3.
CHECK HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) ECU Data Monitor:
(1) The ECU data monitor will indicate if the part is normal or malfunctioning.
Standard:
Door ECU (driver side) (switch condition)
Item
Driver side power window AUTO switch
Jam protection limit switch
Inspecting condition
Standard value
Pressed → Not pressed
ON/OFF
Power window fully open → fully closed
ON/OFF
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2095
05-1906
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Door ECU (driver side) (jam protection threshold)
Item
Inspecting condition
Standard value
Window full-close position → 1/4 open
position
Power window is going UP by manual operation
OK/CAUTION*
Window 1/4 open position → 2/4 open
position
Power window is going UP by manual operation
OK/CAUTION*
Window 2/4 open position → 3/4 open
position
Power window is going UP by manual operation
OK/CAUTION*
Window 3/4 open position → full-open
position
Power window is going UP by manual operation
OK/CAUTION*
HINT:
* : ”CAUTION” is indicated when something is detected in being caught in the window.
(b) Active Test:
(1) The active test will indicate if the part is normal or malfunctioning.
Standard:
Door ECU (driver side)
Item
Power window
Operation
UP/DOWN
(c)
Customizing Function (reference):
(1) Using the hand-held tester, select a setting from the following items on the power window.
Standard:
Door ECU (driver side)
Item
Setting
Power window UP operation interlocked with door
With/Without function
Power window DOWN operation interlocked with door
With/Without function
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2096
05-191 1
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523M-03
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Problem Symptom
Suspected Area
See Page
B1221/21 (Door ECU SW ON)
1. Power window regulator master switch assy
(door ECU)
05-1912
B1231/31 (Driver side jam protection limit switch malfunctions)
1. Power window regulator motor assy LH
05-1913
B1232/32 (Driver side jam protection sensor malfunctions)
1. Power window regulator motor assy LH
05-1913
AUTO UP/AUTO DOWN does not operate (only driver side)
1. Power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU)
2. Power window regulator motor assy LH
05-1913
05-1913
Power window operation is impossible by operation interlocked
with key (only driver side)
1. Front door lock assy RH
2. Power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU)
05-1957
05-1909
Operation is impossible after key-OFF (only driver side)
1. Front door courtesy lamp switch assy
2. Multiplex network body ECU
05-1957
05-1909
Driver’s side power window does not operate
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
P FR DOOR 20 A fuse
ECU-B 7.5 A fuse
IG1 7.5 A fuse
Power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU)
Power window regulator motor assy RH
Wire harness
05-1915
05-1915
05-1915
05-1915
05-1915
05-1915
Window operation via regulator switch for each seat is impossible
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
P FR DOOR 20 A fuse
D FR DOOR 25 A fuse
D RR DOOR 20 A fuse
P RR DOOR 20 A fuse
Power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU)
Power window regulator switch assy
Power window regulator motor assy RH
Power window regulator motor assy LH
Wire harness
05-1920
05-1920
05-1920
05-1920
05-1920
05-1920
05-1920
05-1920
05-1920
Remote operation of other seat via master switch is impossible
1. Power window regulator master switch assy (door ECU)
2. Multiplex network body ECU
3. Wire harness
05-1929
05-1929
05-1929
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2101
05-1909
DIAGNOSTICS
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
0523L-04
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
P5
(a)
(b)
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER
SWITCH ASSY (DOOR ECU)
Disconnect the P5 master switch connector.
Check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the
wire harness side connector.
B51239
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
GND (P5-2) ⇔ Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Condition
Continuity
Specified Condition
CPUB (P5-9) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
L ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
SIG (P5-20) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
Y ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 - 14 V
BDR (P5-10) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
G ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
DN (P5-11) ⇔ UP (P5-1)
GR ⇔ V
Constant
Continuity
LMT (P5-5) ⇔ SGND (P5-13)
O⇔R
Driver side door glass fully closed
No continuity
LMT (P5-5) ⇔ SGND (P5-13)
O⇔R
Driver side door glass opened by 4 mm (0.16 in.) or more
Continuity
KUL (P5-14) ⇔ LSWE (P5-3)
Y ⇔ LG
Driver side door lock cylinder be in neutral by key → UNLOCK
No continuity → Continuity
KL (P5-4) ⇔ LSWE (P5-3)
G ⇔ LG
Driver side door lock cylinder be in neutral by key → LOCK
No continuity → Continuity
If the result is not as specified, the wire harness side may malfunction.
(1) Reconnect the P5 switch connector, and check the voltage of each terminal of the connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
UP (P5-1) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
V ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch ON, master switch driver’s side switch OFF →
UP (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
UP (P5-1) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
V ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch ON, driver side door glass fully opened → master switch driver side switch UP (auto operation) → door glass
fully closed
0 V → 10 - 14 V → 0 V
DN (P5-11) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
GR ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch ON, master switch driver’s side switch OFF →
DOWN (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
DN (P5-11) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
GR ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch ON, driver side door glass fully closed → master
switch driver side switch OFF → DOWN (auto operation) →
door glass fully opened
0 V → 10 - 14 V → 0 V
PWS (P5-6) ⇔ GND (P5-2)
B ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch ON, window lock switch LOCK → NORMAL
0 V → 10 - 14 V
If the result is not as specified, the master switch may malfunction.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2099
05-1910
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
(b)
-
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
Disconnect the body ECU connectors B9, B10, B11 and B12.
Check the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the wire harness side connector.
B11
B12
B9
B10
B51823
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
GND1 (B12-7) ⇔ Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Continuity
GND2 (B9-2) ⇔ Body ground
W-B ⇔ -
Constant
Continuity
BECU (B12-9) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
G ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
BDR1 (B12-4) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
B ⇔ W-B
Constant
10 - 14 V
IG (B9-5) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
BR ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch OFF → ON
0 V → 10 - 14 V
DCTY (B11-1 1) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
B ⇔ W-B
Driver door fully closed → Opened
No continuity → Continuity
KSW (B10-2) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
G ⇔ W-B
No key in ignition key cylinder → Key inserted
No continuity → Continuity
If the result is not as specified, the wire harness side may malfunction.
(c) Reconnect the ECU connectors, and check the voltage of each terminal of the connectors.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
PU (B10-21) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
B ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch ON, master switch passenger side switch OFF
→ UP (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
PD (B10-20) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
GR ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch ON, master switch passenger side switch OFF
→ DOWN (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
RRU (B11-9) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
LG ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch ON, master switch rear RH side switch OFF
→ UP (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
RRD (B11-8) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
BR ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch ON, master switch rear RH side switch OFF
→ DOWN (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
RLU (B11-14) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
O ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch ON, master switch rear LH side switch OFF →
UP (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
RLD (B11-13) ⇔ GND1 (B12-7)
W ⇔ W-B
Ignition switch ON, master switch rear LH side switch OFF →
DOWN (manual operation)
0 V → 10 - 14 V
If the result is not as specified, the door ECU or communication line may malfunction.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2100
05-2145
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQQ-01
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
DESCRIPTION
The ECU controls the cruise control system of the vehicle. The
data and DTCs relating to the cruise control system can be read
from the DLC3 of the vehicle. If no DTCs are output when
checking for DTCs, there may be a problem with the combination meter or the multiplex communication system.
Use the hand-held tester or SST to check and solve the problem.
SST 09843-18040
2.
(a)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CHECK THE DLC3
The vehicle’s ECM uses ISO 9141-2 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies with
SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 9141-2 format.
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
DLC3
F40034
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL(7) - SG(5)
Bus ”+” line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG(4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG(5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT(16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 16 V
HINT:
If the display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE”
when you have connected the hand-held tester to the DLC3,
turned the ignition switch to the ON position and operated the
tester, there is a problem on either the vehicle side or the tool
side.
If communication is normal when the tool is connected to
another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on the original vehicle.
If communication is still impossible when the tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in the
tool itself, so consult the Service Department listed in the
tool’s instruction manual.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2335
05-2146
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
(a)
(b)
CRUISE main
indicator light
I39348
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK THE INDICATOR
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Check that the CRUISE main indicator light comes on
when the cruise control main switch ON-OFF button is
pushed on, and that the indicator light goes off when the
ON-OFF button is pushed off.
HINT:
If there is a problem with the indicator, inspect the cruise main
indicator light circuit (see page 05-2165 ).
HINT:
If a malfunction occurs in the vehicle speed sensors, stop lamp
switch assy or other related parts during cruise control driving,
and the ECM actuates AUTO CANCEL of the cruise control and
then the CRUISE main indicator light starts to blink, informing
the driver of the malfunction. At the same time, data of the malfunction is stored as a diagnostic trouble code, or DTC.
Indicator Light
1.5 sec.
-
0.5 sec.
ON
OFF
BE4034
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2336
05-2149
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQT-02
DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST
1.
(a)
DATA LIST
While the hand-held tester is connected to the DLC3 and with the ignition switch turned to the ON position, the CRUISE CONTROL data list can be displayed. Follow the prompts on the tester screen to
access the data list.
CC (ECM):
Item
Measurement Item /
Display (Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed / min.: 0 km/h (0
mph), max.: 255 km/h (158 mph)
Actual vehicle speed
-
MEMORY SPD
Cruise control memorized speed /
min.: 36 km/h (22.5 mph), max.:
200 km/h (125 mph)
Actual stored vehicle speed
-
THROTTLE
Required throttle opening angle /
min.: 0, max.: 84
Actual required throttle opening
-
CRUISE CONTROL
Cruise control system active
condition / ON or OFF
ON : Cruise control activated
OFF : Cruise control inactivated
-
MAIN SW (MAIN)
Main SW signal (Main CPU) / ON
or OFF
ON : Main SW ON (Pushed on)
OFF: Main SW OFF (Pushed off)
*1
MAIN SW (SUB)
Main SW signal (Sub CPU) / ON
or OFF
ON : Main SW ON (Pushed on)
OFF: Main SW OFF (Pushed off)
*1
CCS INDICATOR M
Cruise indicator signal
(Main CPU) / ON or OFF
ON: CRUISE main indicator light
is on
OFF: CRUISE main indicator light
is off
-
CCS INDICATOR S
Cruise indicator signal
(Sub CPU) / ON or OFF
ON: CRUISE main indicator light
is on
OFF: CRUISE main indicator light
is off
-
CANCEL SW
CANCEL SW signal / ON or OFF
ON : CANCEL SW ON
OFF : CANCEL SW OFF
-
SET/COAST SW
-/SET SW signal / ON or OFF
ON : -/SET SW ON
OFF : -/SET SW OFF
-
RES/ACC SW
+/RES SW signal / ON or OFF
ON : +/RES SW ON
OFF : +/RES SW OFF
-
STP LIGHT SW2-M
Stop lamp SW signal (Main CPU) /
ON or OFF
ON : Brake pedal depressed
OFF : Brake pedal released
-
STP LIGHT SW2-S
Stop lamp SW signal (Sub CPU) /
ON or OFF
ON : Brake pedal depressed
OFF : Brake pedal released
-
STP LIGHT SW1-S
Stop light SW signal (Sub CPU) /
ON or OFF
ON : Brake pedal depressed
OFF : Brake pedal released
-
SHIFT D POS
PNP SW signal (D position) / ON
or OFF
ON : Shift D position
OFF : Except shift D position
-
HINT:
*1 is OK but cruise indicator not turn on → CRUISE MAIN indicator or wire harness or ECM failure
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2339
05-2150
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
2.
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows components such as the relay, VSV, and
actuator to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting
is one way to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) According to the display on the tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
HINT:
The ignition switch must be turned to the ON position to proceed ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester.
COMBINATION METER ASSY:
Item
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Diagnostic Note
CRUISE INDIC
”CRUISE” indicator is ON / OFF
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2340
05-2147
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQR-01
DTC CHECK/CLEAR
1.
(a)
TC
(b)
DLC3
CG
DTC CHECK (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
Using SST check wire, connect terminals TC and CG of
the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
C52361
(c)
Normal System Code
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
ON
(d)
OFF
2.
(a)
Read and record any DTCs from the CRUISE main indicator light on the combination meter. As examples, refer
to the chart on the left for the indications of the normal system code and code 52.
Refer to the Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart (see page
05-2153 ) for DTC information.
DTC CLEAR (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
Remove the battery cable or ECU-IG fuse.
Code 52
0.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
2.5 sec.
ON
OFF
Code 52
I03610
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
DTC CHECK (USING HAND-HELD TESTER)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Read the DTCs on the tester screen.
DTC CLEAR (USING HAND-HELD TESTER)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs following the prompts on the tester
screen.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2337
05-2148
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQS-01
FAIL-SAFE CHART
1.
If the following conditions are detected while the cruise control is in operation, the system
clears the stored vehicle speed in the ECM and cancels the cruise control operation.
Vehicle Condition
Auto Cancel Condition
Re-operation Condition
The CRUISE main indicator light blinks.
There is an open or short in the stop lamp
switch circuit.
There is a problem with the vehicle speed signal.
There is a problem with the throttle position sensor and motor.
Push the ON-OFF button of the cruise control
main switch on again.
The CRUISE main indicator light blinks.
There is a problem with the input circuit of the
stop lamp switch circuit.
There is a problem with the cancel circuit.
Turn the ON-OFF button of the cruise control
main switch on again.
Turn the ignition switch off.
The CRUISE main indicator light goes off.
Vehicle speed is lower than the low speed limit
(approx. 40 km/h (approx. 25 mph)) while running with the cruise control on.
Vehicle speed is lower than the stored speed by
16 km/h (approx. 9.9 mph) or more.
Push the cruise control main switch to -/SET.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2338
05-2155
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQX-02
P0571/52 STOP LIGHT SWITCH CIRCUIT
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the brake pedal is depressed, the stop lamp switch assy sends a signal to the ECM. When the ECM
receives this signal, it cancels the cruise control.
Fail-safe function operates to enable normal driving even if there is a malfunction in the stop lamp signal
circuit.
The cancel condition occurs when positive battery voltage is applied to terminal STP.
When the brake is applied, battery positive voltage is normally applied to terminal STP of the ECM through
the STOP fuse and the stop lamp switch assy, and the ECM turns the cruise control off.
DTC No.
P0571/52
DTC Detection Condition
The malfunction code is output when the voltage of the STP
terminal and that of the ST1- terminal on the ECM are less
than 1 V for 0.5 sec. or more.
Trouble Area
Stop lamp switch assy
Stop lamp switch assy circuit
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2345
05-2156
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
J3 *1
J6 *2
J/C
S15
STOP LAMP SWITCH
ECM
P
P
E
E
12
E6 ST1-
V
4
3
Passenger Side J/B
3
4L
B
1
2
12
4M
BR
19
E6 STP
Instrument Panel J/B
Y
1
1E
STOP
1
1A
6
1G
IGN
1
1C
B
Passenger Side J/B
1
4E
4
4M
W
F7
FL BLOCK
I15
IGNITION SW
AM2
L-Y
10
1
IC1
Y
7 AM2
GR
IG2 6
ALT
W
1
2
FL MAIN
BATTERY
*1: 3MZ-FE
*2: 2AZ-FE
I39315
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2346
05-2157
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(a)
(b)
(c)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and turn the hand-held tester main switch on.
Select the item ”STP LIGHT SW2-M”, ”STP LIGHT SW2-S” or ”STP LIGHT SW1-S” in the DATA LIST,
and read its value displayed on the hand-held tester.
(d) Check that the stop lamp comes on when the brake pedal is depressed, and goes off when the brake
pedal is released.
ECM:
Item
Measurement Item /
Display (Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
STP LIGHT SW2-M
Stop lamp SW signal (Main CPU) /
ON or OFF
ON : Brake pedal depressed
OFF : Brake pedal released
-
STP LIGHT SW2-S
Stop lamp SW signal (Sub CPU) /
ON or OFF
ON : Brake pedal depressed
OFF : Brake pedal released
-
STP LIGHT SW1-S
Stop lamp SW signal (Sub CPU) /
ON or OFF
ON : Brake pedal depressed
OFF : Brake pedal released
-
OK:
When brake pedal operation is performed, the standard values will be above.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
2
INSPECT STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
2
Pushed in ⇔ Free 4
(a)
(b)
1
3
I04062
Disconnect the stop lamp switch assy connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Switch condition
Tester connection
Switch pin free
1-2
Below 1 Ω
Switch pin free
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
1-2
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
3-4
Below 1 Ω
NG
Specified value
REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2347
05-2158
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
Stop Lamp Switch Wire Harness Side
Connector Front View:
(a)
S15
I39310
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S15-2 - Body ground
Always
10 to 16 V
S15-3 - Body ground
Ignition SW ON
10 to 16 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (STOP LAMP SWITCH - BATTERY)
OK
4
INSPECT ECM
Wire Harness View:
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
E6
Reconnect the stop lamp switch connector.
Disconnect the E6 connector from the ECM.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Pedal condition
Tester connection
Specification
Depressed
E6-19 (STP) Body ground
10 to 16 V
Released
E6-19 (STP) Body ground
Below 1 V
Depressed
E6-12 (ST1-) Body ground
Below 1 V
Released
E6-12 (ST1-) Body ground
10 to 16 V
ST1
STP
NG
I36982
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (STOP LAMP SWITCH - ECM)
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2348
05-2159
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05B34-05
P0607/54 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC indicates the internal abnormalities of the ECM.
DTC No.
P0607/54
Detection Item
The ECM has a supervisory CPU and a control ECU inside.
When each input STP signal is different for 0.15 sec. or more,
this trouble code is output.
This trouble code is output after 0.4 sec. has passed from the
time the cruise cancel input signal (STP input) is input into the
ECM.
Trouble Area
ECM
HINT:
The ECM receives signals from each sensor to control all the functions of the cruise control with the microcomputer.
When a trouble code is detected, fail-safe remains on until the ignition switch is turned off.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2349
05-2143
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQP-02
ROAD TEST
1.
(a)
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Inspect the SET function.
(1) Push the ON-OFF button on.
(2) Drive at the required speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or
higher).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to -/SET.
(4) After releasing the switch, check that the vehicle
cruises at the set speed.
(b)
Inspect the ACC (+) switch.
(1) Push the ON-OFF button on.
(2) Drive at the required speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or
higher).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to -/SET.
(4) Check that vehicle speed increases while the cruise
control main switch is pushed to +/RES, and that the
vehicle cruises at the newly set speed when the
switch is released.
(5) Momentarily push the cruise control main switch to
+/RES and then immediately release it. Check that
vehicle speed increases by approximately 1.6 km/h
(1.0 mph) (Tap-up function).
(c)
Inspect the COAST (-) function.
(1) Push the ON-OFF button on.
(2) Drive at the required speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or
higher).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to -/SET.
(4) Check that vehicle speed decreases while the
cruise control main switch is pushed to -/SET, and
the vehicle cruises at the newly set speed when the
switch is released.
(5) Momentarily push the cruise control main switch to
-/SET , and then immediately release it. Check that
vehicle speed decreases by approximately 1.6
km/h (1.0 mph) (Tap-down function).
(1)
(3)
I33808
(3)
(1)
I33808
(1)
(3)
I33808
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2333
05-2144
DIAGNOSTICS
Inspect the CANCEL function.
(1) Push the ON-OFF button on.
(2) Drive at the required speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or
higher).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to -/SET.
(4) When doing one of the followings, check that the
cruise control system is cancelled and that the normal driving mode is reset.
Depressing the brake pedal
Moving the shift lever to any position except
D
Pushing the ON-OFF button off
Pulling the cruise control main switch to CANCEL
(e)
Inspect the RES (RESUME) function.
(1) Push the ON-OFF button on.
(2) Drive at the required speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or
higher).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to -/SET.
(4) When doing one of the followings, check that the
cruise control system is cancelled and that the normal driving mode is reset.
Depressing the brake pedal
Moving the shift lever to any position except
D
Pulling the cruise control main switch to CANCEL
(5) After pushing the cruise control main switch to
+/RES at a driving speed of more than 40 km/h (25
mph), check that the vehicle restores the speed
prior to the cancellation.
(3)
I33808
(1)
I33808
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
(d)
(1)
(4)
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2334
05-2138
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQL-01
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
The computer which controls the cruise control system is combined with the ECM, and the actuator uses
the throttle position sensor and motor. A microcomputer is built into the ECM to control functions including:
ON-OFF , SET/COAST, RESUME/ACCEL, CANCEL, vehicle speed operation, motor output control, and overdrive control.
The ECM compares the driving vehicle speed from the speed sensor with the stored vehicle speed
set through the cruise control main switch assy. The ECM instructs the throttle valve motor of the
throttle position sensor and motor to close the valve when the driving vehicle speed is greater than
the stored vehicle speed, and instructs it to open the valve when the driving speed is less than the
stored speed.
The ECM receives signals such as ON-OFF, SET/COAST, RESUME/ACCEL, and CANCEL from the
cruise control main switch assy and executes them.
The ECM turns on the indicator in the combination meter based upon the ON signal from the cruise
control main switch assy.
The ECM cancels the cruise control system when it detects that the brake pedal is depressed, based
on the stop lamp switch signal.
The ECM cancels the cruise control system when it detects that the shift position is changed from D
to N, based on the park/neutral position switch assy signal.
2.
LIMIT CONTROL
(a) Low speed limit
The lowest possible limit of the speed setting range is set at approximately 40 km/h (25 mph). The
cruise control system cannot be set when the driving vehicle speed is below the low speed limit. Cruise
control operation will be automatically canceled and the stored vehicle speed will be erased when the
vehicle speed goes below the low speed limit while the cruise control is in operation.
(b) High speed limit
The highest possible limit of the speed setting range is set at approximately 200 km/h (125 mph). The
cruise control system cannot be set when the driving vehicle speed is over the high speed limit. Speed
up using RESUME/ACCEL with the cruise control main switch assy also cannot be set beyond the high
speed limit.
3.
OPERATION OF CRUISE CONTROL
The cruise control main switch operates seven functions: SET, COAST(-), TAP-DOWN, RESUME, ACCEL(+), TAP-UP and CANCEL. The SET, TAP-DOWN and COAST functions, and the RESUME, TAP-UP
and ACCEL functions are operated with the same switch. The cruise control main switch assy is an automatic
return type switch which turns on only while operating it in each arrow direction and turns off after releasing
it.
(a) SET CONTROL
Vehicle speed is stored and constant speed control is maintained when pushing the switch to -/SET
while driving with the cruise control main switch ON-OFF button on (the CRUISE main indicator light
is on), and the vehicle speed is within the set speed range (between the low and high speed limits).
(b) COAST CONTROL
The ECM makes the cruise control demanding throttle opening angle zero degrees and decelerates
the vehicle (the throttle valve is not fully closed due to idle speed control, etc.) when -/SET on the cruise
control main switch is pressed and held while the cruise control system is in operation. Vehicle speed,
when the cruise control main switch is released from -/SET, is stored and constant speed control is
maintained.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2328
05-2139
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
(c)
TAP-DOWN CONTROL
When tapping down on the cruise control main switch to -/SET (for approx. 0.5 second) while the cruise
control system is in operation, the stored vehicle speed decreases each time by approximately 1.6
km/h (1.0 mph). However, when the difference between the driving and the stored vehicle speed is
more than 5 km/h (approx. 3.1 mph), the vehicle speed, when the cruise control main switch is released
from -/SET, will be stored and constant speed control is maintained.
(d) ACCELERATION CONTROL
The throttle valve motor of the throttle position sensor and motor is instructed by the ECM to open the
valve when +/RES on the cruise control main switch is pressed and held while the cruise control system
is in operation. Vehicle speed, when the cruise control main switch is released from +/RES, is stored
and the vehicle is controlled at a constant speed.
(e) TAP-UP CONTROL
When tapping up on the cruise control main switch to +/RES (for approx. 0.5 second) while the cruise
control system is in operation, the stored vehicle speed increases each time by approximately 1.6 km/h
(1.0 mph). However, when the difference between the driving and the stored vehicle speed is more
than 5 km/h (approx. 3.1 mph), the stored vehicle speed will not be changed.
(f)
RESUME CONTROL
If cruise control operation was cancelled with the stop lamp switch or the CANCEL switch, and if driving
speed is within the limit range, pushing the cruise control main switch to +/RES restores vehicle speed
memorized at the time of cancellation, and maintains constant speed control.
(g) MANUAL CANCEL CONTROL
Doing any of the following cancels the cruise control system while in operation. (The stored vehicle
speed in the ECM is maintained.)
Depressing the brake pedal
Moving the shift lever to any position except D
Pushing the cruise control main switch to CANCEL
Pushing the cruise control main switch ON-OFF button off (The stored vehicle speed in the ECM
is not maintained.)
4.
AUTO CANCEL (FAIL-SAFE)
This system has an automatic cancellation function (fail-safe) (for details, see page 05-2148 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2329
05-2142
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQO-01
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
VIN
Production Date
Customer’s Name
Licence Plate No.
Date Vehicle
Brought in
/
/
Date Problem
Occurred
Condition of
Frequency
Problem Occurrence Problem Occurs
/
Continuous
/
Intermittent (
Vehicle Speed when
Problem Occurred
Symptoms
km
mile
Odometer Reading
times a day)
km
mile
Auto cancel
occurs
Driving condition
City driving
Freeway
Uphill
Downhill
After cancel occurred, did the driver activate cruise control
again?
Yes
No
Cancel does not
occur
With brake ON
Except shifting into D position
When control SW turns to CANCEL position
Cruise control
malfunction
Slip to acceleration side
Slip to deceleration side
Hunting occurs
Switch
malfunction
SET ACCEL(+) COAST(-) RESUME CANCEL
CRUISE MAIN
indicator light
Remains ON
1st Time
Normal System Code
Trouble Code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal System Code
Trouble Code (Code
)
Does not light up
Blinks
DTC Check
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2332
05-2153
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQV-01
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
Using SST 09843-18040, connect terminals TC and CG of the DLC3.
If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code. For details
of each code, refer to the ”See page” under respective ”DTC No.” in the DTC chart.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Circuit Inspection
Trouble Area
P0500/21
(05-2154 )
Vehicle Speed Sensor Circuit Malfunction
Vehicle speed sensor
Vehicle speed sensor signal circuit
ECM
P0503/23
(05-2154 )
Vehicle Speed Sensor Circuit Malfunction
Vehicle speed sensor
Vehicle speed sensor signal circuit
ECM
P0571/52
(05-2155 )
Stop Light Switch Circuit Malfunction
Stop lamp switch assy
Stop lamp switch assy circuit
ECM
P0607/54
(05-2159 )
Input Signal Circuit Malfunction
ECM
Author:
Date:
2343
05-2140
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQN-02
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
The hand-held tester can be used at steps 4, 5, 6, and 11.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORK SHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS (SEE PAGE 05-2142 )
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
4
CHECK BODY MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 05-2040 )
(a) Check for output DTCs.
HINT:
The ECM of this system is connected to the multiplex communication system. Therefore, before starting troubleshooting, make sure to check that there is no trouble in the multiplex communication system.
MULTIPLEX SYSTEM DTC IS OUTPUT (PROCEED TO ”BODY MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM”)
NO MULTIPLEX SYSTEM DTC (GO TO STEP 5)
5
DTC CHECK AND CLEAR (SEE PAGE 05-2147 )
6
DTC CHECK (OTHER THAN MULTIPLEX DTC) (SEE PAGE 05-2147 )
TROUBLE CODE (GO TO STEP 7)
NORMAL SYSTEM CODE (GO TO STEP 8)
7
DTC CHART (SEE PAGE 05-2153 )
GO TO STEP 11
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2330
05-2141
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOM SIMULATION
SYMPTOM DOES NOT OCCUR (GO TO STEP 9)
SYMPTOM OCCURS (GO TO STEP 10)
9
SYMPTOM SIMULATION (SEE PAGE 01-26 )
10
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE PAGE 05-2152 )
11
CIRCUIT INSPECTION (SEE PAGE 05-2154 - 05-2166 )
12
TERMINALS OF ECM (SEE PAGE 05-2151 )
13
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
14
REPAIR OR REPLACE
15
CONFIRMATION TEST
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2331
05-2154
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQW-02
DTC
P0500/21 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CIRCUIT
MALFUNCTION
DTC
P0503/23 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CIRCUIT
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
3MZ-FE: See page 05-578 .
2AZ-FE: See page 05-216 .
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0500/21
This trouble code is output when the vehicle speed signal from
the vehicle speed sensor is cut for 0.14 sec. or more while the
cruise control is in operation.
Vehicle speed sensor
Vehicle speed sensor signal circuit
ECM
P0503/23
Momentary interruption and noise are detected when a rapid
change of vehicle speed occurs while the cruise control is in
operation.
Vehicle speed sensor
Vehicle speed sensor signal circuit
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
3MZ-FE: See page 05-578 .
2AZ-FE: See page 05-216 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
3MZ-FE: See page 05-578 .
2AZ-FE: See page 05-216 .
Author:
Date:
2344
05-2137
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQK-01
LOCATION
Park/neutral Position
Switch
Combination Meter
ECM
Spiral Cable Sub-assy
Skid Control ECU
Instrument
Panel J/B
STOP Fuse
IGN Fuse
Cruise
Control
Main
Switch
DLC3
Stop Lamp Switch
I39351
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2327
05-2136
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQZ-01
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Pay attention to the following points when inspecting the cruise control system.
Push the cruise control main switch ON-OFF button off when not using the cruise control.
Be careful of vehicle speed increase when driving downhill with the cruise control on.
RESUME/ACCEL operation, after canceling the cruise control, works as RESUME, and works as ACCEL while the cruise control system is in operation.
Push the cruise control main switch ON-OFF button off and reset the cruise control if the CRUISE main
indicator light blinks while the cruise control system is in operation. When the cruise control cannot be
set by this procedure or cancelled immediately after setting, there may be a malfunction in the system.
Do not use the cruise control system where the road conditions are as follows:
Heavy traffic
Steep downhill
Sharp turns
Icy or snowy roads
Slippery roads
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2326
05-2152
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05IQU-02
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
If a normal system code is displayed during the DTC check but the problem still occurs, check the circuits
for each problem symptom in the order given in the table below and proceed to the relevant troubleshooting
page.
HINT:
Inspect the ”Fuse” and ”Relay” before confirming the suspected areas as shown in the chart below.
Inspect each malfunction circuit in numerical order for the corresponding symptom.
If the malfunction still exists even after checking and confirming that all the circuits are normal, replace the
ECM.
Symptom
Suspected Area
See page
Main switch cannot be turned ON.
(Cruise indicator light in combination meter does not come on.)
3. Cruise control switch circuit
4. CRUISE main indicator light circuit
5. ECM
05-2160
05-2165
10-24
Vehicle speed setting cannot be done.
(Although indicator light in combination meter comes on when the
main switch is turned ON, it goes off when vehicle speed is set.)
1. Cruise control switch circuit
2. ECM
05-2160
10-24
1. Cruise control switch circuit
2. Stop lamp switch circuit
3. Park/neutral position switch circuit
05-2160
05-2155
05-1036
05-922
05-1109
05-981
05-1868
10-24
Setting cannot be done.
(Indicator light in combination meter comes on when the main
switch is turned ON and they remain ON while setting.)
4. Transmission control switch circuit
U151E/U151F
U241E/U141F
U151E/U151F
U241E/U141F
5. Combination meter system
6. ECM
1. Cruise control switch circuit
2. Vehicle speed sensor circuit
While the vehicle is driven with cruise control, the set control is
cancelled.
(Indicator light and CRUISE remain ON.)
3. Stop lamp switch circuit
4. CRUISE main indicator light circuit
5. Park/neutral position switch circuit
3MZ-FE
2AZ-FE
U151E/U151F
U241E/U141F
6. ECM
2. ECM
05-578
05-216
10-24
Setting cannot be cancelled.
(When Coast, Acceleration, Resume, Set speed change and Control switch are operated.)
1. Cruise control switch circuit
2. ECM
05-2160
10-24
DTC is not output, or is output when should not be.
1. Diagnosis circuit
2. ECM
05-2166
10-24
CRUISE MAIN indicator light does not come on.
1.
2.
3.
4.
05-2160
05-2165
10-24
71-18
Hunting
(Speed is not constant.)
1. Vehicle speed sensor circuit
3MZ-FE
2AZ-FE
05-2160
05-578
05-216
05-2155
05-2165
05-1036
05-922
10-24
Cruise control switch circuit
CRUISE main indicator light circuit
ECM
Combination meter assy
Author:
Date:
2342
05-2151
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
05B31-08
TERMINALS OF ECM
E7
E8
E9
E6
E5
I30693
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
TC - E1
(E5-20 - E9-1) *1
(E5-20 - E7-1) *2
O - BR
Ground
Ignition switch ON →
Connect terminals TC and CG of
DLC3
10 to 16 V →
Below 1 V
STP - E1
(E6-19 - E9-1) *1
(E6-19 - E7-1) *2
BR - BR
Stop lamp signal
Ignition switch ON
Depress brake pedal → Release
brake pedal
10 to 16 V →
Below 1 V
Ignition switch ON
CANCEL switch hold ON
-/SET switch hold ON
+/RES switch hold ON
MAIN switch hold ON
10 to 16 V
6.6 to 11.4 V
4.5 to 8.1 V
2.3 to 4.5 V
Below 1 V
Ignition switch ON
Depress brake pedal → Release
brake pedal
Below 1 V →
10 to 16 V
CCS - E1
(E6-24 - E9-1) *1
(E6-24 - E7-1) *2
LG - BR
Cruise control main
switch circuit
ST1- - E1
(E6-12 - E9-1) *1
(E6-12 - E7-1) *2
V - BR
Stop lamp signal
Condition
Specified Condition
*1: 2AZ-FE
*2: 3MZ-FE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2341
05-756
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05IP2-01
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ambient temperature sensor sends the outside temperature signal to the ECM. The ECM transmits the
signal to the skid control ECU as a communication signal. The skid control ECU controls the tire pressure
warning system, depending on the changes of the outside temperature.
HINT:
The signal sent from the ambient temperature sensor is also used in the A/C.
WIRING DIAGRAM
S27
Skid Control ECU
With Actuator
ENG+ 9
ENG-
23
ECM
W-L
W-G
B-R
5
V
24
E5
R
30
E5 ENG-
B
32
E6
TAM
28
E7
E2
IC4
18
IC4
5
IK3
A1
A/C Ambient Temp.
Sensor
BR
2
1
6
EB2
BR
Short Connector
5
5
BR
S29
S28
ENG+
F46778
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC CODE OUTPUT
Check if the normal code is output by air conditioning system (see page 05-1 117).
OK:
DTC is not output.
NG
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
946
05-757
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY - ECM)
(SEE PAGE 01-36 )
(a)
Wire Harness Side:
S27 ENG+
(b)
(c)
ENGWire Harness Side:
ENG+
Disconnect the brake actuator assy S27 connector and
ECM E5 connector.
Measure the resistance between each terminal of brake
actuator assy and ECM wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester connection
Specified condition
S27-9 (ENG+) - E5-24 (ENG+)
Below 1 Ω
S27-23 (ENG-) - E5-30 (ENG-)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance between each terminal of the
brake actuator assy wire harness side connector and
body ground.
Standard:
Tester connection
Specified condition
S27-9 (ENG+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S27-23 (ENG-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E5
F45562
F45165
ENGF45563
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
947
05-758
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
INSPECT ECM(ENG+, ENG- OUTPUT)
(a)
ECM:
ENG+
E9
E1
E5
(b)
(c)
Connect the brake actuator assy S27 connector and ECM
E5 connector.
Remove the ECM with the connectors connected.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
ENGA53769
Normal Signal Waveform: ENG + terminal
(d)
Using an oscilloscope, connect the terminals, as shown
in the chart below.
Tester Connection
E5-24 (ENG+) - E9-1 (E1)
(e)
GND
1 V / Division
0.5 ms / Division
F45157
Normal Signal Waveform: ENG- terminal
With the engine idling, check the output waveform.
OK:
Signal waveform appears as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
As the vehicle speed increases, the waveform cycle narrows.
(f)
Using an oscilloscope, connect the terminals, as shown
in the chart below.
Tester Connection
E5-30 (ENG-) - E9-1 (E1)
(g)
GND
1 V / Division
0.5 ms / Division
F45158
With the engine idling, check the output waveform.
OK:
Signal waveform appears as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
As the engine speed increases, the waveform cycle narrows.
NG
REPLACE ECM
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
948
05-759
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
INSPECT AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
(a)
Ambient Temperature Sensor:
(b)
A1
I30155
Remove the ambient temperature sensor and disconnect
the A1 connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A1-1 - A1-2
50F (10C)
3.00 to 3.73 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
59F (15C)
2.45 to 2.88 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
68F (20C)
1.95 to 2.30 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
77F (25C)
1.60 to 1.80 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
86F (30C)
1.28 to 1.47 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
95F (35C)
1.00 to 1.22 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
104F (40C)
0.80 to 1.00 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
113F (45C)
0.65 to 0.85 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
122F (50C)
0.50 to 0.70 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
131F (55C)
0.44 to 0.60 kΩ
A1-1 - A1-2
140F (60C)
0.36 to 0.50 kΩ
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the resistance decreases (see
the chart below).
NOTICE:
Even slightly touching the sensor may change the resistance value. Be sure to hold the connector of the sensor.
4.0
3.5
3.0
2.5
Resistance
(kΩ)
MIX
2.0
MAX
1.5
1.0
5.0
0.0
0
20
40
68
104
60
C
140 F
Temperature (C)
I38777
NG
REPLACE AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
949
05-760
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(ECM - AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
(SEE PAGE 01-36 )
(a)
(b)
Wire harness side:
Disconnect the ECM E6 and E7 connectors.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
A1
Wire harness side:
Condition
Specified condition
E6-32 (TAM) - A1-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
E7-28 (E2) - A1-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
E6-32 (TAM) - Body
ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
E7-28 (E2) - Body
ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
E6
E7
E2
Tester connection
NG
TAM
F46780
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-9 OR 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
950
05-744
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05EZ0-02
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
(a)
BAT
SIL
DLC3
CG
C52361
DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM
Inspect the battery voltage.
Battery voltage: 11 to 14 V
If voltage is below 11 V, recharge the battery before proceeding.
(b) Check the DLC3.
The vehicle’s skid control ECU uses ISO 9141-2 for communication. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches with the ISO 9141-2
format.
Verify conditions listed in the table below:
Terminal No.
Terminal name
Connection / Voltage or
Resistance
Condition
7
SIL
Bus + Line / Pulse generation
During transmission
4
CG
Chassis Ground to Body
Ground / 1 Ω or less
Always
16
BAT
Battery Positive to Body
Ground / 10 to 14 V
Always
HINT:
If the hand-held tester displays ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO
VEHICLE” when the cable of the hand-held tester is properly
connected to the DLC3, the ignition switch is turned to the ON
position and the tester is operated, there is either a problem on
the vehicle side or tester side.
If communication is normal when the tester is connected
to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on the original vehicle.
If communication is still not possible when the tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in the
tester itself. In this case, consult the Service Department
listed in the tester’s instruction manual.
2.
(a)
(b)
CHECK WARNING LAMP
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, the
lamp should come on for 3 to 4 seconds and then go off.
HINT:
If the tire pressure warning lamp has a defect, check the tire
pressure warning lamp output patterns and the problem symptoms table (see page 05-740 ).
Tire Pressure
Warning Lamp
Lamp Output Pattern:
Ignition Switch ON
ON
OFF
3 to 4 Sec.
F46775
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
934
05-745
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LAMP CHART:
Priority
1
Condition
Ignition switch is in the ON position.
Tire Pressure Warning Lamp Output Pattern
Tire pressure warning lamp comes on for 3
seconds when the ignition switch is turned to
the ON position. (However, during initialization,
the lamp comes on for 4 seconds.)
3 or 4 Sec.
ON
OFF
Ignition Switch ON
2
System abnormal 1
Tire pressure warning lamp signal is open.
HINT:
When the tire pressure warning lamp drive
signal circuit opens due to a skid control
ECU malfunction, communication error,
open circuit in the wire harness, etc., the
tire pressure warning lamp comes on. (Active Lamp Circuit)
3
System abnormal 2
ABS system malfunction
Speed sensor malfunction
Stop lamp switch assy malfunction
HINT:
The skid control ECU monitors the speed
sensor signal and the stop lamp switch
signal, and the tire pressure warning lamp
blinks.
4
(When in
test mode)
Tire pressure warning reset switch is turned
on during test mode.
(Press and hold the tire pressure warning
reset switch.)
Tire pressure warning lamp comes on
ON
OFF
Signal Circuit Open
Tire pressure warning lamp blinks
(Comes on and goes off repeatedly at 0.5 second intervals.)
0.5 Sec.
ON
OFF
Malfunction
Occurs
0.5 Sec.
HINT:
(When the skid control ECU detects a system
abnormal 2 malfunction, check the ABS DTCs
and proceed to the pages on which the ABS
DTCs are described.)
Tire pressure warning lamp comes on when the
tire pressure warning reset switch is turned on.
Switch Operating
ON
OFF
Switch ON
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
935
05-746
DIAGNOSTICS
Priority
5
-
Condition
Initialization mode is received.
HINT:
See step 3 for initialization procedure.
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Tire Pressure Warning Lamp Output Pattern
Tire pressure warning lamp blinks 3 times
(Comes on and goes off repeatedly at 1 second intervals.)
ON
1 Sec.
Switch ON
OFF
3 Sec.
6
Failure to initialize when driving the
vehicle.
HINT:
3 conditions will indicate this pattern:
1. New vehicle from factory
2. ECM replacement
3. Failure to initialize
1 Sec.
Tire pressure warning lamp blinks
(Comes on and goes off repeatedly at 0.25
second intervals.)
0.25 Sec.
ON
OFF
0.25 Sec.
7
Outputs tire air pressure check result.
HINT:
The result is output only when driving at 19
mph (35 km/h) or more.
Tire pressure is judged to be normal:
Warning light is OFF:
ON
OFF
Tire pressure is judged to be low:
Warning light comes on:
ON
OFF
Judging Low Tire Pressure
HINT:
When the skid control ECU does not operate properly, the ABS warning lamp comes on as an ABS system
malfunction.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
936
05-747
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05EZ1-02
DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST
1.
DATA LIST
HINT:
By accessing the DATA LIST displayed by the hand-held tester, you can read the value of the switches and
sensors without removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Following the display on the tester, select the ”DATA LIST”.
ABS:
Item
Measurement Item / Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light switch / ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal depressed
OFF: Brake pedal released
WHEEL SPD FR
Front right wheel speed reading /
min.: 0 km/h (0 mph)
max.: 326.4 km/h (202 mph)
Actual wheel speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
WHEEL SPD FL
Front left wheel speed reading /
min.: 0 km/h (0 mph)
max.: 326.4 km/h (202 mph)
Actual wheel speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
WHEEL SPD RR
Rear right wheel speed reading /
min.: 0 km/h (0 mph)
max.: 326.4 km/h (202 mph)
Actual wheel speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
WHEEL SPD RL
Rear left wheel speed reading /
min.: 0 km/h (0 mph)
max.: 326.4 km/h (202 mph)
Actual wheel speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed reading /
min.: 0 km/h (0 mph)
max.: 326.4 km/h (202 mph)
Actual vehicle speed
EFI COM
EFI communication open detection
/ Normal or Open
Normal
-
TEST MODE
Test mode / NORMAL or TEST
NORMAL: Normal mode
TEST: During test mode
-
#CODES
Number of DTC recorded / min.: 0,
max.: 255
Min.: 0, Max.: -
-
-
Speed indicated on speedometer
2.
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Perform the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester to operate the ABS warning lights. Performing the
ACTIVE TEST is one of the methods to shorten labor time. It is possible to display the DATA LIST during
the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Following the display on the tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
ABS:
Item
ABS WARN LIGHT
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Diagnostic Note
ABS warning light / ON or OFF
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
937
05-736
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05EYX-02
INITIALIZATION
NOTICE:
This system requires initializing after changing tires or wheels, or after rotating the tires.
Be sure to adjust the tire air pressure to the specified value before initialization.
1.
(a)
INITIALIZING THE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Check and adjust the tire pressure to the specified value.
Specified Value
(b)
(c)
Tire Pressure
Warning Reset Switch
Tire Pressure
Warning Lamp
Lamp Output Pattern:
Receipt of the Initialization Signal
Keep pressing
the switch for 3 sec.
1 Sec.
ON
OFF
3 Sec.
1 Sec.
Failure of Initialization
0.25 Sec.
ON
OFF
0.25 Sec.
F46772
Front
210 kpa (2.1 kgf/cm2, 30 psi)
Rear
210 kpa (2.1 kgf/cm2, 30 psi)
With the vehicle stopped, turn the ignition switch to the
ON position.
Press and hold the tire pressure warning reset switch until
the tire pressure warning lamp blinks 3 times at 1 second
intervals.
HINT:
If the tire pressure warning lamp does not blink, perform the initialization again. (with the ignition switch off, perform the procedure above starting at step 1-(b).)
(d) Drive the vehicle at 19 mph (30 km/h) or more, to complete the initialization of the skid control ECU. (It takes
more than one hour.)
HINT:
If the tire pressure warning lamp blinks at 0.25 second intervals
while the vehicle is being driven, the initialization may have
failed. If so, perform the initialization again. (Turn the ignition
switch off and retry from step 1-(a).)
(e) After initialization is completed, the skid control ECU monitors the tire pressure by using the wheel speed sensors.
(f)
To verify the system has been initialized check the length
of time the tire pressure warning lamp is on after turning
the ignition switch to the ON position.
Not initialized: 4 sec.
Initialized: 3 sec.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
926
05-733
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05CLA-03
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
(a)
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The tire pressure warning system informs the driver if it detects a low tire pressure. When the tire pressure warning system detects low tire pressure in any of the 4 wheels, which affects safe driving the
tire pressure warning lamp comes on.
Specified Value
Front
210 kpa (2.1 kgf/cm2, 30 psi)
Rear
210 kpa (2.1 kgf/cm2, 30 psi)
(b) Tire pressure warning system is controlled by the skid control ECU.
HINT:
When the tire pressure reset switch is push, the tire pressure warning lamp goes off.
2.
(a)
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING DISPLAY FUNCTION
The tire pressure warning lamp comes on, according to
the condition of the tire pressure warning system, as
shown in the DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM (see page 05-744 ).
Tire Pressure
Warning Lamp
F46769
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
923
05-732
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05EYW-02
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Tire Pressure Warning
Reset Switch
Ambient Temperature
Sensor
ECM
Skid
Control
ECU
Right Front Speed Sensor
Left Front Speed Sensor
Right Rear Speed Sensor
Left Rear Speed Sensor
Stop Lamp Switch Assy
Combination Meter Assy
(Tire Pressure Warning Lamp)
F46771
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
922
05-748
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05IOZ-02
STOP LAMP SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the stop lamp switch is ON (brake pedal depressed), the skid control ECU suspends the tire pressure
warning system.
WIRING DIAGRAM
S15
Stop Light SW
Passenger Side J/B
3
4L
B
2
S27
Skid Control ECU
With Actuator
1
11
4A
B
22
IC4
G-Y
27
STP
Instrument Panel J/B
Y
1
1E
STOP
1
1A
B
W-B
32
A
J4
J/C
F7
FL Block
FL MAIN
ALT
W
1
Battery
GND1
B
2
W-B
EA
W-B
EB
F46776
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
938
05-749
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH OPERATION
Check that the stop lamp comes on when the brake pedal is depressed, and goes off when the brake
pedal is released.
OK:
Stop lamp functions normally.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY - STOP LAMP
SWITCH ASSY) (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
Wire Harness Side:
(a)
(b)
STP
S27
GND1
Disconnect the brake actuator assy connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Switch condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Brake pedal depressed
S27-27 (STP) S27-32 (GND1)
10 to 14 V
Brake pedal released
S27-27 (STP) S27-32 (GND1)
Below 1.5 V
F45562
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-740 )
3
CHECK REAR COMBINATION LAMP ASSY LH
NG
REPLACE REAR COMBINATION LAMP ASSY
LH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
939
05-750
DIAGNOSTICS
4
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
INSPECT STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
Stop Lamp Switch Assy:
2
Free
-
1
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the stop lamp switch assy S15 connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Switch condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Switch pin free
1-2
Below 1 Ω
Switch pin pushed in
1-2
10 kΩ or higher
Pushed In
F45894
NG
REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
OK
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY - STOP LAMP
SWITCH ASSY) (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
Wire Harness Side:
(a)
(b)
(c)
STP
S27
GND1
F45562
Connect the stop lamp switch assy S15 connector.
Disconnect the brake actuator assy connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Switch condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Brake pedal depressed
S27-27 (STP) S27-32 (GND1)
10 to 14 V
Brake pedal released
S27-27 (STP) S27-32 (GND1)
Below 1.5 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-740 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
940
05-752
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05IP0-02
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RESET SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Receiving the signal from the tire pressure warning reset switch, the skid control ECU indicates initialization
of the tire pressure warning system.
WIRING DIAGRAM
P22
Tire Pressure Warning
Reset Switch
Passenger Side J/B
W-B
7
4L
6
W-B
4J
2
1
SB
S27
Skid Control ECU
With Actuator
2
B-Y
IC4
41
INIT
J4
J/C
W-B
A
W-B
32
GND1
W-B
IC
EB
EA
F46777
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RESET SWITCH (SEE PAGE 05-737 )
OK:
Tire pressure warning reset switch functions normally.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
CORRECT TIRE PRESSURE TO THE SPECIFIED PRESSURE, THEN INITIALIZE THE SYSTEM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
942
05-753
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
INSPECT TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RESET SWITCH
Tire Pressure Warning Reset Switch:
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the tire pressure warning reset switch P22
connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
ON
OFF
2
Switch condition
Specified condition
ON
Below 1 Ω
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
1
F44158
NG
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RESET
SWITCH
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RESET
SWITCH - BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY) (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
(a)
Wire Harness Side:
(b)
(c)
S27
GND1
INIT
Reconnect the tire pressure warning reset switch P22
connector.
Disconnect the brake actuator assy connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Switch condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
ON
S27-41 (INIT) S27-32 (GND1)
Below 1 Ω
OFF
S27-41 (INIT) S27-32 (GND1)
10 kΩ or higher
F45562
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-740 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
943
05-751
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05EZ4-02
ABS SYSTEM MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU outputs DTCs when a speed sensor malfunction occurs or there is an open in the stop
lamp switch assy circuit of the ABS system. If ABS system has a malfunction, tire pressure warning system
will not function.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE OUTPUT
Check that the normal code is output by ABS system (see page 05-765 ).
OK:
DTC is not output.
NG
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-740 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
941
05-754
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05IP1-03
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LAMP CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the tire pressure decreases, the skid control ECU illuminates the tire pressure warning lamp on the
combination meter assy.
HINT:
Refer to the ”TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LAMP CHART” section in the ”DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM” for the tire
pressure warning lamp (see page 05-744 ).
WIRING DIAGRAM
S27
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
ECM
30
E5
R
18
IC4
W-G
23
S27 ENG-
24
ENG+ E5
V
5
IC4
W-L
9
S27 ENG+
TRC+
25
E5
Y
7
IC4
G-B
TRC-
31
E5
G
19
IC4
Y-B
ENG-
MPX1
S27 TRC+
22
Multiplex Communication Circuit
MPX2
8
29
E6
S27 TRC-
Combination Meter
9
C12 MPX+
21
C11 MPX-
18
E6
F45964
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
944
05-755
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSY(TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LAMP)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Check the tire pressure warning lamp.
OK:
Tire pressure warning lamp comes on for 3 or 4 seconds.
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-18 )
OK
2
(a)
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC CODE OUTPUT
Check if the normal code is output by SFI system (see page 05-38 or 05-400 ).
OK:
No DTC output from SFI system.
NG
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
OK
3
(a)
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC CODE OUTPUT
Check if the normal code is output by VSC system (see page 05-765 ).
OK:
No DTC output from VSC system.
NG
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-740 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
945
05-737
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05EYY-02
TEST MODE PROCEDURE
1.
(a)
(b)
TS
(c)
DLC3
TEST MODE (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
Make sure the ignition switch off.
Using SST, connect terminals TS and CG of the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
CG
C52361
S
Tire Pressure Warning
Reset Switch
Lamp Output Pattern:
Normal Condition
(d) Press the tire pressure warning reset switch.
(e) Check that the tire pressure warning lamp comes on.
HINT:
Unless (d) above is done, the tire pressure warning lamp
remains off while in test mode.
When there is a problem with the tire pressure warning
system, the tire pressure warning lamp blinks at 0.5 second intervals.
If the lamp output result is not normal, proceed to the problem
symptoms table or TS terminal circuit.
Tire Pressure
Warning Lamp
OFF
Switch
Operating
See page
Problem symptoms table
05-740
TS and CG terminal circuit
05-873
(f)
(g)
Switch ON
ON
Item
Turn the ignition switch off.
Remove the SST from the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
System Malfunction
0.5 Sec.
ON
OFF
0.5 Sec.
F46773
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
927
05-738
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(h)
(i)
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Check that the tire pressure warning lamp goes off.
Initialize the tire pressure warning system
(see page 05-736 ).
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
TEST MODE (USING THE HAND-HELD TESTER)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Select ”SIGNAL CHECK”, and proceed checking with the
hand-held tester.
Tire Pressure
Warning Lamp
Lamp Output Pattern:
Ignition Switch ON
ON
OFF
3 to 4 Sec.
F46775
Hand-Held
Tester
DLC3
F46779
Tire Pressure Warning
Reset Switch
Lamp Output Pattern:
Normal Condition
Switch ON
ON
OFF
Tire Pressure
Warning Lamp
(d) Press the tire pressure warning reset switch.
(e) Check that the tire pressure warning lamp comes on.
HINT:
Unless (d) above is done, the tire pressure warning lamp
remains off while in test mode.
When there is a problem with the tire pressure warning
system, the tire pressure warning lamp blinks at 0.5 second intervals.
If the lamp output result is not normal, proceed to the problem
symptoms table (see page 05-740 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch off.
Switch
Operating
System Malfunction
0.5 Sec.
ON
OFF
0.5 Sec.
F46773
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
928
05-739
DIAGNOSTICS
(g)
(h)
(i)
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Check that the tire pressure warning lamp goes off.
Initialize the tire pressure warning system
(see page 05-736 ).
Tire Pressure
Warning Lamp
Lamp Output Pattern:
Ignition Switch ON
ON
OFF
3 to 4 Sec.
F46775
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
929
05-735
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05BW7-05
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
Inspector’s
:
Name
Tire Pressure Warning System Check Sheet
VIN
Production Date
Customer’s Name
/
/
Licence Plate No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
km
miles
Odometer Reading
/
Date Problem First Occurred
/
Frequency Problem Occurs
Continuous
/
Intermittent (
times a day)
In spite of abnormal low pressure of the tire pressure,the warning
lamp does not come on.
The warning lamp was on and the tire was filled up with air, but
the warning lamp does not go off.
Symptoms
Tire Pressure
Warning Lamp
Abnormal
Remains ON
Does not Come on
ABS Warning Lamp
Normal
Malfunction Code (Code
)
) RR (
) RL (
)
Tire Pressure
FR (
) FL (
Tire Size
Check Item
Tire
FR (
) FL (
) RR (
) RL (
)
FR (
Tire Type
) FL (
) RR (
) RL (
)
FR (
Tire Wear Condition
) FL (
) RR (
) RL (
)
History of Changing Tires or Wheels
When (
)
History of Rotating Tires
When (
)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
925
05-734
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05BW6-05
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
The hand-held tester can be used at steps 3, 6 and 9.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS (SEE PAGE 05-735 )
3
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 05-2040 )
(a)
Check that DTC is output.
DTC IS OUTPUT (PROCEED TO ”MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM”)
DTC IS NOT OUTPUT (Go to step 4)
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LAMP CONDITION
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Record the condition of the tire pressure warning lamp on the combination meter assy.
Refer to the ”TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LAMP CHART” section of the DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM for
checking the condition of the tire pressure warning lamp (see page 05-744 ).
5
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE PAGE 05-740 )
6
CIRCUIT INSPECTION (SEE PAGE 05-748 to 05-756 )
7
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
8
REPAIR
9
CONFIRMATION TEST
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
924
05-731
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05CLC-04
LOCATION
Right Rear Speed Sensor
Brake Actuator Assy
(Skid Control ECU)
Right Front Speed Sensor
Left Rear
Speed Sensor
4WD:
Left Rear
Speed Sensor
Ambient Temperature Sensor
Left Front Speed Sensor
Combination Meter Assy
Tire Pressure Warning Lamp
ABS Warning Lamp
ECM
Stop Lamp Switch Assy
DLC3
Tire Pressure Warning Reset Switch
F46770
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
921
05-729
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05CL9-03
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM PRECAUTION
When the tire pressure warning lamp comes on, immediately check the air pressure of all tires and adjust to the
specified pressure.
Specified Value
Tire Pressure
Warning Lamp
(b)
F46769
(c)
Front
210 kpa (2.1 kgf/cm2, 30 psi)
Rear
210 kpa (2.1 kgf/cm2, 30 psi)
This system requires initializing after changing tires or
wheels, or after rotating the tires (see page 28-1 ).
Set tire pressure within the specified range before initializing. If the tire air pressure is not within the specified range,
the tire pressure warning system will not function.
In the following cases, the system may not operate normally.
A compact spare tire, snow tires, or tire chains are
used.
The tire pressure is excessively higher than specified, or tire pressure suddenly drops due to bursting
or other causes.
The vehicle is driven on a slippery road surface
such as rough or frozen roads.
The vehicle speed is 19 mph (30 km/h) or less or
more than 62 mph (100 km/h) , and the driving duration is less than 5 minutes.
The tires differ in tread pattern or manufacture.
The tires are not the specified size.
The tread wear is very different among the installed
tires.
Rapid acceleration/deceleration or sharp turns is
continued.
Towing a trailer.
The loading is over the limit or imbalanced.
Initialization was not performed correctly after replacing or rotating tires or wheels.
The outside temperature is below 32F (0C) or
above 104F (40C).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
919
05-730
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
(b)
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
When a system malfunction occurs in the tire pressure warning system, the tire pressure warning lamp
blinks.
The result of this diagnosis is stored in the skid control ECU.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
920
05-740
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05BWC-05
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Check the circuits for each problem symptom in the order given in the table below, and proceed to the relevant troubleshooting page.
HINT:
Inspect each circuit in numerical order for the corresponding symptom.
If the malfunction still exists even after checking and confirming that all the circuits are normal, replace
the brake actuator assy.
When a malfunction is found in the skid control ECU, replace the brake actuator assy.
When the tire pressure warning lamp blinks and the ABS warning lamp comes on, check the ABS system first.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Tire pressure warning lamp does not come on after ignition switch
is turned ON.
3. Tire pressure warning lamp circuit
4. Combination meter assy
5. Brake actuator assy
05-754
05-1868
-
Tire pressure warning lamp remains on after ignition switch is
turned ON.
HINT:
System abnormal 1 is detected.
Low pressure is detected.
1. Check tire pressure and press the tire pressure reset
switch a few seconds.
2. Tire pressure warning lamp circuit
3. Combination meter assy
4. Brake actuator assy
05-754
05-1868
-
Tire pressure warning lamp blinks at 0.5 second intervals.
HINT: System abnormal 2 is detected.
1. Stop lamp switch circuit
2. Vehicle speed sensor
3. ABS system malfunction
05-748
05-788
05-751
Tire pressure warning lamp blinks at 0.25 second intervals.
HINT: ECU requires initialization.
1. Initialize the tire pressure warning system
2. Brake actuator assy
05-736
-
ECU is initialized (tire pressure warning reset switch is ON), but
tire pressure warning lamp does lit.
1. Check initialization
2. Tire pressure warning reset switch circuit
3. Brake actuator assy
05-736
05-752
-
Tire pressure warning lamp comes on while driving, but lamp goes
off without supplying tire air pressure.
1. Check tire pressure warning lamp
2. Tire pressure warning lamp circuit
3. Combination meter assy
4. Brake actuator assy
HINT:
Tire pressure may be affected by the driving environment.
When any of the detected pressures reach standard tire
pressure value, the warning lamp may go off.
05-744
05-744
05-754
-
Tire pressure warning lamp comes on, but tire air pressure is
within the standard value.
1. Check if vehicle has the appropriate size tire.
2. Ambient temperature sensor circuit
3. Tire pressure warning lamp circuit
4. Combination meter assy
5. Brake actuator assy
HINT:
Using inappropriate size tires, or not using the indicated
tires.
Tire pressure is not adjusted at initialization.
05-756
05-754
05-1868
-
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
930
05-741
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Tire pressure warning lamp remains off, even when tire air pressure decreased.
1. Check if vehicle has the appropriate size tires.
2. Ambient temperature sensor circuit
3. Tire pressure warning lamp circuit
4. Combination meter assy
5. Brake actuator assy
HINT:
Using inappropriate size tires.
Tire pressure may be affected by the driving environment.
Since tire pressure decreases in cold weather, the pressure warning lamp may come on.
Tire pressure is not adjusted at initialization.
05-756
05-754
05-1868
-
Tire pressure warning lamp comes on while driving, and lamp
remains lit after correcting tire pressure.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
05-744
05-754
05-1868
05-756
-
Test mode cannot be completed.
1. ABS system malfunction
2. TS terminal circuit
3. Brake actuator assy
Press the tire pressure reset switch a few seconds.
Check tire pressure warning lamp
Tire pressure warning lamp circuit
Combination meter assy
Ambient temperature sensor circuit
Brake actuator assy
05-751
05-873
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
931
05-742
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
05IOX-02
TERMINALS OF ECU
SKID CONTROL ECU:
S27
F45156
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
TRC+ (8) - TRC- (22)
G-B - Y-B
ECM communication output
Ignition switch ON
ENG+ (9) - GND1 (32)
W-L - W-B
ECM serial communication line (+) input signal
Ignition switch ON and vehicle
speed 30 km/h (19 mph) or more
D/G (13) - GND1 (32)
GR-B - W-B
Diagnosis tester communication line
Ignition switch ON
ENG- (23) - GND1 (32)
W-G - W-B
ECM serial communication line (-) input signal
Ignition switch ON and engine idle
speed
STP (27) - GND1 (32)
G-Y - W-B
Stop lamp switch assy input signal
Brake pedal depressed
STP (27) - GND1 (32)
G-Y - W-B
Stop lamp switch assy input signal
Brake pedal released
GND1 (32) - Body ground
W-B Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
INIT (41) - GND1 (32)
B-Y - W-B
Tire pressure warning reset switch signal
Ignition switch ON and tire pressure
warning reset switch ON
Below 3 V
INIT (41) - GND1 (32)
B-Y - W-B
Tire pressure warning reset switch signal
Ignition switch ON and tire pressure
warning reset switch OFF
10 to 14 V
Pulse generation
Pulse generation
(See wave form 1)
10 to 14 V
Pulse generation
(See wave form 2)
10 to 14 V
Below 1.5 V
Wave form 1:
Reference
Item
Condition
Terminal
ENG+ - GND1
Tool setting
1 V / DIV, 0.5 ms / DIV
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
GND
F45157
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
932
05-743
DIAGNOSTICS
-
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Wave form 2:
Reference
Item
Condition
Terminal
ENG- - GND1
Tool setting
1 V / DIV, 0.5 ms / DIV
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
GND
F45158
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
933
05-2131
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05IR7-02
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (CAN-L) FOR SHORT TO GND
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A short to GND is suspected in the CAN bus line when there is continuity between terminals 4 (CG) and 14
(CANL) of the DLC3.
Symptom
Trouble Area
Short to GND in CAN bus line (CANL)
Skid control ECU
Steering sensor
Yaw rate sensor
There is continuity between terminals 4 (CG) and 14
(CANL) of DLC3.
WIRING DIAGRAM
S14
Steering Sensor
J16
J/C
CANH
VSC
Y
10
10
CANL
2
STRG
L
12
IC4
B
W
13
IC4
W
8
VSC
STRG
21
W
9
ESS
Skid Control ECU
With Actuator
19
11
S27 CANH
25
S27 CANL
W-B
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
CANH
CANL
1 GND
12
IO2
G
13
IO2
W
B
3
W
2
9
20
YAW
YAW
D3
DLC3
CANH
CANL
W-B
B
11 DLC3
6
W
14
22
W-B
DLC3
1
S27 GND2
32
S27 GND1
Passenger Side J/B
CG
W-B
4
6
4C
1
4N
W-B
3
4C
1
4N
W-B
J19
J/C
W-B
W-B
A
A
BF
J4
J/C
IC
EH
EB
A
G30963
Author:
Date:
2321
05-2132
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND(DLC3 SUB BUS LINE, CAN-L)
(a)
Disconnect the wire harness connector (J16) from the
junction connector.
(b)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Junction Connector:
J16
CANH
CANL
G26430
G25476
DLC3:
CG
1
2
3
4
D3
5
6
7
8
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-4 (CG) D3-14 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
CANL
G25474
C81825
NG
G26206
REPAIR OR REPLACE DLC3 SUB BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (CAN-L)
OK
2
(a)
CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Reconnect the wire harness connector (J16) to the junction connector.
Author:
Date:
2322
05-2133
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND(SKID CONTROL ECU, CAN-L)
DLC3:
(a)
CG
D3
(b)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
Disconnect the connector (S27) from the skid control
ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-4 (CG) D3-14 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
3 kΩ or more
CANL
G25474
C81825
G26206
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL
ACTUATOR (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
ECU
WITH
NG
4
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND(STEERING SENSOR, CAN-L)
DLC3:
CG
1
2
3
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
D3
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
Reconnect the connector (S27) to the skid control ECU.
Disconnect the connector (S14) from the steering sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-4 (CG) D3-14 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
3 kΩ or more
CANL
G25474
C81825
G26206
OK
REPLACE STEERING SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-48 )
NG
5
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND(YAW RATE SWENSOR, CAN-L)
DLC3:
CG
1
2
3
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
D3
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
G25474
C81825
Reconnect the connector (S14) to the steering sensor.
Disconnect the connector (Y1) from the yaw rate sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-4 (CG) D3-14 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
3 kΩ or more
CANL
G26206
OK
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-46 )
NG
Author:
Date:
2323
05-2134
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND(SKID CONTROL ECU - JUNCTION
CONNECTOR, CAN-L)
(a)
(b)
Junction Connector:
J16
(c)
CANH
Reconnect the connector (Y1) to the yaw rate sensor.
Disconnect the wire harness connector (J16) from the
junction connector.
Disconnect the connector (S27) from the skid control
ECU.
CANL
G26430
G25476
(d)
Skid Control ECU
Connector Front
View:
S27
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S27-25 (CANL) S27-32 (GND1)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ more
NG
GND1
CANL
E69126
REPAIR OR REPLACE CAN MAIN BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - JUNCTION CONNECTOR, CAN-L)
OK
Author:
Date:
2324
05-2135
DIAGNOSTICS
7
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND(STEERING SENSOR - JUNCTION
CONNECTOR, CAN-L)
Steering Sensor Wire Harness View:
S14
ESS
CANL
G24991
-
G26210
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the connector (S14) from the steering sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S14-2 (ESS) S14-9 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ more
HINT:
Check the wire harness connector connected to the junction
connector while disconnecting them.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CAN MAIN BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (STEERING SENSOR - JUNCTION CONNECTOR, CAN-L)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-L)
Author:
Date:
2325
05-2109
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05DY7-11
CHECK CAN MAIN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The CAN main bus line and DLC3 sub bus line may have a disconnection when the resistance between terminals 6 (CANH) and 14 (CANL) of the DLC3 is more than 69 Ω.
Symptom
Trouble Area
Resistance between terminals 6 (CANH) and 14 (CANL) of
DLC3 is more than 69 Ω .
CAN main bus line
Skid control ECU
Steering sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
S14
Steering Sensor
CANH
CANL
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
J16
J/C
Y
10 STRG
10
W
9
21 STRG
VSC
L
12
IC4
B
11
S27 CANH
W
13
IC4
W
25
S27 CANL
8
VSC
19
G30960
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2299
05-21 10
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DLC3
DLC3:
D3
1
2
3
4
5
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Result:
CANH
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
G25474
C81825
CANL
G26206
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
Result
D3-6 (CANH) D3-14 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
108 to 132 Ω
A
D3-6 (CANH) D3-14 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
132 Ω or more
B
NOTICE:
When the measured value is 132 Ω or more and the CAN
communication system diagnostic code is output, there
may be a fault besides disconnection of the DLC3 sub bus
line. For that reason, troubleshooting should be performed
again from ”How to proceed with troubleshooting” after repairing the trouble area.
B
REPAIR OR REPLACE DLC3 SUB BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
A
2
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC
Read the output diagnostic codes.
Standard:
U0073/94, U0123/62, U0124/95 and U0126/63 are output simultaneously.
A
Only U0126/63 is output.
B
NOTICE:
Diagnostic codes other than the CAN communication system diagnostic codes (U0073/94, U0123/62,
U0124/95, U0126/63) may be output simultaneously with the CAN codes.
B
Go to step 4
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2300
05-21 11
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN MAIN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION(SKID CONTROL ECU JUNCTION CONNECTOR)
Skid Control ECU Connector
Front View:
CANH
CANL
(a)
S27
E69126
(b)
Disconnect the connector (S27) from the skid control
ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S27-11 (CANH) S27-25 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
108 to 132 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CAN MAIN BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - JUNCTION CONNECTOR)
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU WITH ACTUATOR (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
4
CHECK CAN MAIN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION(STEERING SENSOR JUNCTION CONNECTOR)
Steering Sensor Wire Harness View:
S14
G24991
CANH
CANL
G26210
(a)
(b)
(c)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the connector (S14) from the steering sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S14-10 (CANH) S14-9 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
108 to 132 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CAN MAIN BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (STEERING SENSOR - JUNCTION CONNECTOR)
OK
REPLACE STEERING SENSOR (SEE PAGE 32-48 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2301
05-21 12
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05IR3-02
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The CAN bus lines are considered to be shorted when the resistance between terminals 6 (CANH) and 14
(CANL) of the DLC3 is below 54 Ω.
Symptom
Trouble Area
Resistance between terminals 6 (CANH) and 14 (CANL) of
DLC3 is below 54 Ω.
Short in CAN bus lines
Skid control ECU
Steering sensor
Yaw rate sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
S14
Steering Sensor
CANH
CANL
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
J16
J/C
Y
10
10
STRG
W
21 STRG
9
VSC
L
12
IC4
B
11
S27 CANH
W
13
IC4
W
25
S27 CANL
8
VSC
19
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
CANH
CANL
B
3
W
2
12
IO2
G
13
IO2
W
9
20
YAW
YAW
G30961
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2302
05-21 13
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT(DLC3 SUB BUS LINE)
Junction Connector:
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the wire harness connector (J16) from the
junction connector.
(c)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
J16
CANH
CANL
G26430
G25476
DLC3:
D3
1
2
3
CANH
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-6 (CANH) D3-14 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
CANL
G25474
C81825
G26206
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE DLC3 SUB BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
OK
2
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT(SKID CONTROL ECU - JUNCTION
CONNECTOR)
Skid Control ECU
Connector Front
View:
(a)
CANH
CANL
S27
(b)
E69126
Disconnect the connector (S27) from the skid control
ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S27-11 (CANH) S27-25 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Check the wire harness connector connected to the junction
connector while disconnecting it.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CAN MAIN BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2303
05-21 14
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU WITH ACTUATOR(CANH - CANL)
(a)
Skid Control ECU:
CANH
CANL
G26199
G28087
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
11 (CANH) - 25 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
108 to 132 Ω
NG
REPLACE SKID CONTROL
ACTUATOR (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
ECU
WITH
OK
4
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT(STEERING SENSOR - JUNCTION
CONNECTOR)
Steering Sensor Wire Harness View:
(a)
(b)
S14
G24991
CANH
CANL
G26210
Disconnect the connector (S14) from the steering sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S14-10 (CANH) S14-9 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Check the wire harness connector connected to the junction
connector while disconnecting it.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STEERING SENSOR
SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H,
CAN-L)
OK
5
INSPECT STEERING SENSOR(CANH - CANL)
(a)
Steering Sensor:
G25475
G24692
CANH
CANL
G26209
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
10 (CANH) - 9 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
108 to 132 Ω
NG
REPLACE STEERING SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-48 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2304
05-21 15
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT(YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE)
(a)
(b)
Yaw Rate Sensor Connector
Front View:
Y1
CANL
CANH
G26359
Disconnect the connector (Y1) from the yaw rate sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
Y1-3 (CANH) Y1-2 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Check the wire harness connector connected to the junction
connector while disconnecting it.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR SUB
BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
OK
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR (SEE PAGE 32-46 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2305
05-21 16
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05IR4-03
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (CAN-H) FOR SHORT TO +B
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A short to +B is suspected in the CAN bus line when there is continuity between terminals 16 (BAT) and 6
(CANH) of the DLC3.
Symptom
Trouble Area
Short to +B in CAN bus line (CANH)
Skid control ECU
Steering sensor
Yaw rate sensor
There is continuity between terminals 16 (BAT) and 6
(CANH) of DLC3.
WIRING DIAGRAM
S14
Steering Sensor
J16
J/C
VSC
CANH
Y
10
CANL
3 BAT
Skid Control ECU
With Actuator
STRG
10
9
12
IC4
B
W
13
IC4
W
8
VSC
W
L
21 STRG
19
D3
DLC3
CANH
CANL
B
G
YAW
9
DLC3
11
6
W
YAW
14
22
DLC3
W
20
11
S27 CANH
25
S27 CANL
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
12
IO2
B
13
IO2
W
3
2
CANH
CANL
Instrument Panel J/B
10
1E
W
BAT
16 J17
J/C
P
P
E
E
10
1G
B
BR
5
IC3
4
2A
W-L
Engine Room J/B
W
W
3
ALT
1
1A
9
1D
F7
FL Block
1
FL
MAIN
OBD
1
2I
2
SHORT PIN ECU-B
31
S27 +BS
B
8
Battery
G30962
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2306
05-21 17
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B(DLC3 SUB BUS LINE, CAN-H)
(a)
Disconnect the wire harness connector (J16) from the
junction connector.
(b)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Junction Connector:
J16
CANH
CANL
G26430
G25476
DLC3:
D3
1
2
CANH
3
4
5
6
7
8
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-6 (CANH) D3-16 (BAT)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
NG
BAT
G25474
C81825
G26206
REPAIR OR REPLACE DLC3 SUB BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (CAN-H)
OK
2
(a)
CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Reconnect the wire harness connectors (J16) to the junction connector.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2307
05-21 18
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B(SKID CONTROL ECU, CAN-H)
(a)
DLC3:
D3
CANH
(b)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
BAT
G25474
C81825
G26206
Disconnect the connector (S27) from the skid control
ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-6 (CANH) D3-16 (BAT)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL
ACTUATOR (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
ECU
WITH
NG
4
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B(STEERING SENSOR, CAN-H)
DLC3:
D3
1
2
3
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
CANH
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
BAT
G25474
C81825
G26206
Reconnect the connector (S27) to the skid control ECU.
Disconnect the connector (S14) from the steering sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-6 (CANH) D3-16 (BAT)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
OK
REPLACE STEERING SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-48 )
NG
5
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B(YAW RATE SENSOR, CAN-H)
DLC3:
D3
1
2
3
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
CANH
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
G25474
C81825
BAT
G26206
Reconnect the connector (S14) to the steering sensor.
Disconnect the connector (Y1) from the yaw rate sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-6 (CANH) D3-16 (BAT)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
OK
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-46 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2308
05-21 19
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B(SKID CONTROL ECU - JUNCTION
CONNECTOR, CAN-H)
(a)
(b)
Junction Connector:
(c)
J16
CANH
Reconnect the connector (Y1) to the yaw rate sensor.
Disconnect the wire harness connector (J16) from the
junction connector.
Disconnect the connector (S27) from the skid control
ECU.
CANL
G26430
G25476
Skid Control ECU
Connector Front
View:
(d)
CANH
S27
+BS
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S27-11 (CANH) S27-31 (+BS)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
NG
E69126
REPAIR OR REPLACE CAN MAIN BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - JUNCTION CONNECTOR, CAN-H)
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2309
05-2120
DIAGNOSTICS
7
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B(STEERING SENSOR - JUNCTION
CONNECTOR, CAN-H)
Steering Sensor Wire Harness View:
S14
BAT
CANH
G24991
-
G26210
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the connector (S14) from the steering sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S14-10 (CANH) S14-3 (BAT)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Check the wire harness connector connected to the junction
connector while disconnecting it.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CAN MAIN BUS LINE
OR CONNECTOR (STEERING SENSOR - JUNCTION CONNECTOR, CAN-H)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2310
05-2121
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05IR5-03
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (CAN-L) FOR SHORT TO +B
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A short to the +B is suspected in the CAN bus line when there is continuity between terminals 16 (BAT) and
14 (CANL) of the DLC3.
Symptom
Trouble Area
Short to +B in CAN bus line (CANL)
Skid control ECU
Steering sensor
Yaw rate sensor
There is continuity between terminals 16 (BAT) and 14
(CANL) of DLC3.
WIRING DIAGRAM
S14
Steering Sensor
J16
J/C
VSC
CANH
Y
10
CANL
3 BAT
Skid Control ECU
With Actuator
STRG
10
9
12
IC4
B
W
13
IC4
W
8
VSC
W
L
21 STRG
19
D3
DLC3
CANH
CANL
B
11
6
DLC3
W
G
YAW
9
YAW
14
22
DLC3
W
20
11
S27 CANH
25
S27 CANL
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
12
IO2
B
13
IO2
W
3
2
CANH
CANL
Instrument Panel J/B
10
1E
W
BAT
16 J17
J/C
P
P
E
E
10
1G
B
BR
5
IC3
4
2A
W-L
Engine Room J/B
W
3
ALT
1
1A
9
1D
F7
FL Block
1
FL
MAIN
OBD
1
2I
2
SHORT PIN ECU-B
31
S27 +BS
B
8
Battery
G30962
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2311
05-2122
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B(DLC3 SUB BUS LINE, CAN-L)
(a)
Disconnect the wire harness connector (J16) from the
junction connector.
(b)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Junction Connector:
J16
CANH
CANL
G26430
G25476
DLC3:
D3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
CANL
G25474
C81825
BAT
G26206
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-14 (CANL) D3-16 (BAT)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE DLC3 SUB BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (CAN-L)
OK
2
(a)
CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Reconnect the wire harness connector (J16) to the junction connector.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2312
05-2123
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B(SKID CONTROL ECU, CAN-L)
(a)
DLC3:
D3
(b)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
CANL
G25474
C81825
BAT
G26206
Disconnect the connector (S27) from the skid control
ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-14 (CANL) D3-16 (BAT)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL
ACTUATOR (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
ECU
WITH
NG
4
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B(STEERING SENSOR, CAN-L)
DLC3:
(a)
(b)
(c)
D3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
CANL
G25474
C81825
BAT
G26206
Reconnect the connector (S27) to the skid control ECU.
Disconnect the connector (S14) from the steering sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-14 (CANL) D3-16 (BAT)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
OK
REPLACE STEERING SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-48 )
NG
5
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B(YAW RATE SENSOR, CAN-L)
DLC3:
(a)
(b)
(c)
D3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
G25474
C81825
CANL
BAT
Reconnect the connector (S14) to the steering sensor.
Disconnect the connector (Y1) from the yaw rate sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-14 (CANL) D3-16 (BAT)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
OK
G26206
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-46 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2313
05-2124
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B(SKID CONTROL ECU - JUNCTION
CONECTOR, CAN-L)
(a)
(b)
Junction Connector:
J16
(c)
CANH
Reconnect the connector (Y1) to the yaw rate sensor.
Disconnect the wire harness connector (J16) from the
junction connector.
Disconnect the connector (S27) from the skid control
ECU.
CANL
G26430
G25476
(d)
Skid Control ECU
Connector Front
View:
S27
+BS
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S27-25 (CANL) S27-31 (+BS)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
NG
CANL
E69126
REPAIR OR REPLACE CAN MAIN BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - JUNCTION CONNECTOR, CAN-L)
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2314
05-2125
DIAGNOSTICS
7
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B(STEERING SENSOR - JUNCTION
CONNESTOR, CAN-L)
Steering Sensor Wire Harness View:
BAT
CANL
(a)
(b)
S14
G24991
-
G26210
Disconnect the connector (S14 ) from the steering sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S14-9 (CANL) S14-3 (BAT)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Check the wire harness connector connected to the junction
connector while disconnecting it.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CAN MAIN BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (STEERING SENSOR - JUNCTION CONNECTOR, CAN-L)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-L)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2315
05-2126
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05IR6-03
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (CAN-H) FOR SHORT TO GND
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A short to GND is suspected in the CAN bus line when there is continuity between terminals 4 (CG) and 6
(CANH) of the DLC3.
Symptom
Trouble Area
There is continuity between terminals 4 (CG) and 6 (CANH)
of DLC3.
Short to GND in CAN bus line (CANH)
Skid control ECU
Steering sensor
Yaw rate sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
S14
Steering Sensor
J16
J/C
CANH
VSC
Y
10
10
CANL
2
STRG
L
12
IC4
B
W
13
IC4
W
8
VSC
STRG
21
W
9
ESS
Skid Control ECU
With Actuator
19
11
S27 CANH
25
S27 CANL
W-B
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
CANH
CANL
1 GND
12
IO2
G
13
IO2
W
B
3
W
2
9
20
YAW
YAW
D3
DLC3
CANH
CANL
W-B
B
11 DLC3
6
W
14
22
W-B
DLC3
1
S27 GND2
32
S27 GND1
Passenger Side J/B
CG
W-B
4
6
4C
1
4N
W-B
3
4C
1
4N
W-B
J19
J/C
W-B
W-B
A
A
BF
J4
J/C
IC
EH
EB
A
G30963
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2316
05-2127
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND(DLC3 SUB BUS LINE, CAN-H)
(a)
Disconnect the wire harness connector (J16) from the
junction connector.
(b)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Junction Connector:
J16
CANH
CANL
G26430
G25476
DLC3:
CG
1
2
3
4
CANH
D3
5
6
7
8
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-4 (CG) D3-6 (CANH)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
NG
G25474
C81825
G26206
REPAIR OR REPLACE DLC3 SUB BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (CAN-H)
OK
2
(a)
CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Reconnect the wire harness connector (J16) to the junction connector.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2317
05-2128
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND(SKID CONTROL ECU, CAN-H)
DLC3:
CG
(a)
CANH
D3
(b)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
G25474
C81825
G26206
Disconnect the connector (S27) from the skid control
ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-4 (CG) D3-6 (CANH)
Ignition SW OFF
3 kΩ or more
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL
ACTUATOR (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
ECU
WITH
NG
4
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND(STEERING SENSOR, CAN-H)
DLC3:
CG
1
2
3
4
D3
5
6
(a)
(b)
(c)
CANH
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
G25474
C81825
G26206
Reconnect the connector (S27) to the skid control ECU.
Disconnect the connector (S14) from the steering sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-4 (CG) D3-6 (CANH)
Ignition SW OFF
3 kΩ or more
OK
REPLACE STEERING SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-48 )
NG
5
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND(YAW RATE SENSOR, CAN-H)
DLC3:
CG
1
2
3
4
D3
5
6
(a)
(b)
(c)
CANH
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
G25474
C81825
G26206
Reconnect the connector (S14) to the steering sensor.
Disconnect the connector (Y1) from the yaw rate sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-4 (CG) D3-6 (CANH)
Ignition SW OFF
3 kΩ or more
OK
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-46 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2318
05-2129
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND(SKID CONTROL ECU - JUNCTION
CONNECTOR, CAN-H)
(a)
(b)
Junction Connector:
J16
(c)
CANH
Reconnect the connector (Y1) to the yaw rate sensor.
Disconnect the wire harness connector (J16) from the
junction connector.
Disconnect the connector (S27) from the skid control
ECU.
CANL
G26430
G25476
Skid Control ECU
Connector Front
View:
(d)
CANH
S27
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S27-11 (CANH) S27-32 (GND1)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
NG
GND1
E69126
REPAIR OR REPLACE CAN MAIN BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (SKID CONTROL ECU - JUNCTION CONNECTOR, CAN-H)
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2319
05-2130
DIAGNOSTICS
7
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND(STEERING SENSOR - JUNCTION
CONNECTOR, CAN-H)
Steering Sensor Wire Harness View:
S14
ESS
CANH
G24991
-
G26210
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the connector (S14) from the steering sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S14-2 (ESS) S14-10 (CANH)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Check the wire harness connector connected to the junction
connector while disconnecting it.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CAN MAIN BUS LINE OR
CONNECTOR (STEERING SENSOR - JUNCTION CONNECTOR, CAN-H)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2320
05-2102
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05DY5-04
CHECK CAN BUS LINE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When any DTC for the CAN communication is output, first measure the resistance between the terminals
of DLC3 to specify the trouble area.
WIRING DIAGRAM
S14
Steering Sensor
CANH
CANL
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
J16
J/C
Y
10
10
STRG
W
21 STRG
9
VSC
L
12
IC4
B
W
13
IC4
W
8
VSC
19
11
S27 CANH
25
S27 CANL
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
CANH
CANL
B
3
W
2
12
IO2
G
13
IO2
W
9
20
YAW
YAW
D3
DLC3
CANH
CANL
B
11
6
W
14
22
DLC3
DLC3
Passenger Side J/B
CG
6
4C
W-B
4
1
4N
W-B
Instrument Panel J/B
BAT
10
1E
W
16 F7
FL Block
FL MAIN
W
1
ALT
OBD
1
1A
B
2
IC
Battery
G30957
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2292
05-2103
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE(MAIN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION, BUS LINES FOR
SHORT CIRCUIT)
DLC3:
D3
1
2
3
4
5
(a)
(b)
CANH
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
CANL
G25474
C81825
G26206
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
Result
D3-6 (CANH) D3-14 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
54 to 69 Ω
OK
D3-6 (CANH) D3-14 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
69 Ω or more
NG-A
D3-6 (CANH) D3-14 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
54 Ω or less
NG-B
NG-A
CHECK
CAN
MAIN
BUS
LINE
DISCONNECTION (SEE PAGE 05-2109 )
FOR
NG-B
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT
(SEE PAGE 05-21 12)
OK
2
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (CAN-H) FOR SHORT TO +B
(a)
DLC3:
CANH
D3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-6 (CANH) D3-16 (BAT)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
NG
G25474
C81825
BAT
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (CAN-H) FOR SHORT
TO +B (SEE PAGE 05-21 16)
G26206
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2293
05-2104
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (CAN-L) FOR SHORT TO +B
(a)
DLC3:
D3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-14 (CANL) D3-16 (BAT)
Ignition SW OFF
1 MΩ or more
NG
CANL
G25474
C81825
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
BAT
G26206
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (CAN-L) FOR SHORT TO
+B (SEE PAGE 05-2121 )
OK
4
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (CAN-H) FOR SHORT TO GND
DLC3:
CG
1
2
3
4
5
(a)
CANH
D3
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-4 (CG) D3-6 (CANH)
Ignition SW OFF
3 kΩ or more
NG
G25474
C81825
G26206
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (CAN-H) FOR SHORT
TO GND (SEE PAGE 05-2126 )
OK
5
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (CAN-L) FOR SHORT TO GND
(a)
CG
DLC3:
1
2
D3
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
G25474
C81825
CANL
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
D3-4 (CG) D3-14 (CANL)
Ignition SW OFF
3 kΩ or more
NG
G26206
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (CAN-L) FOR SHORT TO
GND (SEE PAGE 05-2131 )
OK
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING (SEE PAGE 05-2095 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2294
05-2105
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05IR2-02
STEERING SENSOR COMMUNICATION STOP MODE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
U0126/63
When ECU terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 V or more, data is
not received from the steering sensor for more than 1 sec.
When ECU terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 V or more, data
can not be received from the steering sensor more than
once within 5 sec. This situation repeatedly occurs more
than 10 times.
Trouble Area
Steering sensor
Power source of steering sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
S14
Steering Sensor
J16
J/C
STRG
STRG
Y
10
10
W
9
21
CANH
CANL
Passenger Side J/B
Y
4
4J
11
4C
L
7
4L
3
4C
W-B
1
2
IG1
ESS
W-B
Instrument Panel J/B
10
1D
ECU-IG
1
1A
AM1
F7 FL Block
W
1
ALT
B
2
1
I15
Ignition SW
7
1C
G
6
1C
W
4 IG1
AM1 2
2
FL MAIN
IC
Battery
G30958
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2295
05-2106
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS(IG1, ESS)
Steering Sensor Wire Harness View:
S14
G24991
(a)
(b)
(c)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the connector (S14) from the steering sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
ESS
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
IG1
S14-2 (ESS) Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
G26210
(d)
(e)
Connect the connector (S14) to the steering sensor.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
S14-1 (IG1) Body ground
Ignition SW ON
10 to 14 V
NOTICE:
Perform the measurement from the back of the connector
with the connector connected.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE STEERING SENSOR (SEE PAGE 32-48 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2296
05-2107
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05DY8-04
YAW RATE SENSOR COMMUNICATION STOP MODE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
U0123/62
When ECU terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 V or more, data is
not received from the yaw rate sensor for more than 1
sec.
When ECU terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 V or more, data
can not be received from the yaw rate sensor more than
once within 5 sec .This situation repeatedly occurs more
than 10 times.
Yaw rate sensor
Yaw rate sensor sub bus line
Power source of yaw rate sensor
U0124/95
When ECU terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 V or more, data is
not received from the deceleration the sensor for more
than 1 sec.
When ECU terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 V or more, data
can not be received from the deceleration sensor more
than once within 5 sec. This situation repeatedly occurs
more than 10 times.
Yaw rate sensor
Yaw rate sensor sub bus line
Power source of yaw rate sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
J16
J/C
YAW
YAW
G
9
W
20
12
IO2
B
13
IO2
W
3
2
CANH
CANL
Passenger Side J/B
2
4C
4
4J
Y
3
IO2
V
5
Instrument Panel J/B
10
1D
ECU-IG
1
1A
AM1
F7 FL Block
W
1
B
ALT
2
FL MAIN
Battery
1
O
IG
I15
Ignition SW
7
1C
G
6
1C
W
4 IG1
2
AM1 2
J19
J/C
W-B
A
W-B
A
1
GND
BF
G30959
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2297
05-2108
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION(YAW RATE SENSOR SUB BUS
LINE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Yaw Rate Sensor Connector
Front View:
Y1
CANL
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the connector (Y1) from the yaw rate sensor.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
CANH
G26359
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
Y1-2 (CANL) Y1-3 (CANH)
Ignition SW OFF
54 to 69 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR SUB
BUS LINE OR CONNECTOR (CAN-H, CAN-L)
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS(IG,GND)
(a)
Yaw Rate Sensor Connector
Front View:
Y1
GND
IG
G26359
(b)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
Y1-1 (GND) Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified value
Y1-5 (IG) - Body ground
Ignition SW ON
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR (SEE PAGE 32-46 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2298
05-2090
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05BYH-15
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
2.
(a)
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS ON STEERING SYSTEM
Care must be taken when replacing parts. Incorrect replacement could affect the performance of the
steering system and result in a driving hazard.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS ON SRS AIRBAG SYSTEM
The HIGHLANDER is equipped with a SRS (Supplemental Restraint System), such as the driver airbag and front passenger airbag. Failure to carry out service operation in the correct sequence could
cause the SRS to unexpectedly deploy during servicing, possibly leading to a serious accident. Before
servicing (including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read the precautionary notice for the Supplemental Restraint System (see page 60-1 ).
3.
(a)
F45104
WIRE HARNESS REPAIR
After repairing the wire bus line with solder, wrap the repaired part with vinyl tape.
NOTICE:
The CANL bus line and CANH bus line must be
installed together all the time.
When installing, make sure to twist them.
The difference in length of the CANL bus line and
CANH bus line should be within 100 mm (3.937 in.).
Untwisted parts around the connectors should be
within 80 mm (3.150 in.).
(b) Do not perform bypass wiring between the connectors.
NOTICE:
If you perform bypass wiring, the characteristic of the
twisted wire harness will be lost.
Bypass Wire
F45105
4.
(a)
CONNECTOR HANDLING
When inserting tester probes into a connector, insert them
from the back of the connector.
F45106
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2280
05-2091
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
Repair Wire
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
If it is impossible to check resistance from the back of the
connector, use a repair wire to check it.
F45107
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2281
05-2093
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05DY2-04
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Serial Communication Line
DLC3
Steering Sensor
Skid Control ECU
120 Ω
10 %
120 Ω
10 %
Junction
Connector
: CAN Main Bus Line
(CAN-H)
Yaw Rate
Sensor
: CAN Main Bus Line
(CAN-L)
: CAN Sub Bus Line
(CAN-H)
: CAN Sub Bus Line
G26354
(CAN-L)
HINT:
The Skid Control ECU stores DTCs and performs DTC communication by receiving information from the
Steering Sensor and Yaw Rate Sensor. These sensors cannot store DTCs or perform DTC communication.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2283
05-2096
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05BYQ-06
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
CAN Communication System Check Sheet
Inspector’s
:
Name
VIN
/
Production Date
Customer’s Name
/
Licence Plate No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
/
km
miles
Odometer Reading
Date Problem First Occurred
/
Continuously
Frequency Problem Occurs
/
Intermittently (
times a day)
1st Time
Normal System Code
Trouble Code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal System Code
Trouble Code (Code
)
DTC Check
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2286
05-2094
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05DY3-12
DESCRIPTION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
2.
(a)
(b)
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
4.
(a)
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
BRIEF DESCRIPTION
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial data communication system for real time application. It is a
vehicle multiplex communication system which has a high communication speed (500 kbps) and the
ability to detect malfunctions.
The CAN performs the communication based on the differential voltage by pairing the CANH bus line
and CANL bus line.
The HIGHLANDER uses the CAN communication system for communication between the following
ECU and sensors in the ABS with EBD & BA & TRC & VSC system.
The CAN has two resistors of 120 Ω that are necessary for communication to the main bus line.
DEFINITION OF TERMS
Main bus line
(1) Main bus line is a wire harness between the two terminus circuits on the bus (communication
line). This is the main bus in the CAN communication system.
Sub bus line
(1) Sub bus line is a wire harness which diverges from the main bus line, which is the main bus of
the CAN bus, to an ECU or sensor.
ECU OR SENSORS WHICH COMMUNICATE THROUGH THE CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Skid Control ECU
Steering Sensor
Yaw Rate Sensor
DIAGNOSTIC CODES FOR THE CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTCs for CAN system are as follows:
U0073/94, U0123/62, U0124/95, U0126/63
REMARKS FOR TROUBLESHOOTING
Trouble in the CAN bus (communication line) can be checked from the DLC3 (except a wire break other
than in the DLC3 sub bus line).
By using the hand-held tester, DTCs for the CAN communication system can be checked through the
DTC ISO 9141K-Line.
The CAN communication system cannot detect the trouble in the DLC3 sub bus line even though the
DLC3 is also connected to the CAN communication system.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2284
05-2101
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05BYL-13
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
1.
DTCs COMBINATION TABLE
NOTICE:
Complete ”CHECK CAN BUS LINE” (see page 05-2102 ), to confirm that there is no disconnection in
the CAN main bus lines and there is no short circuit, short to +B or short to ground in the CAN bus
lines. Then perform troubleshooting according to the DTC combination table.
(a) Confirm the trouble mode according to the combination of output DTCs.
Trouble Mode
U0073/94
U0123/62
U0124/95
U0126/63
Skid control ECU communication stop mode
Yaw rate sensor communication stop mode
-
Steering sensor communication stop mode
-
-
-
HINT:
(b)
U0073/94, U0123/62, U0124/95 and U0126/63 are the DTCs in the CAN communication system.
The above table shows combinations of these DTCs.
..... DTCs that are being output.
- ...... DTCs that are not being output.
Confirm the trouble mode by referring to the above. Then check the parts to be replaced and pages
to proceed to, by referring to the below.
Output Code
See page and
parts to be replaced
Suspected Area
Skid control ECU communication stop mode
(U0073/94, U0123/62, U0124/95 and U0126/63 are output simultaneously)
Skid control ECU
Yaw rate sensor communication stop mode
(U0123/62 and U0124/95 are output simultaneously)
Open circuit between yaw rate sensor and junction connector
Yaw rate sensor power source/internal malfunction
05-2107
Steering sensor communication stop mode
(U0126/63 only)
Steering sensor power source/internal malfunction
05-2105
Replace skid
control ECU
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2291
05-2095
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05BYJ-06
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
NOTICE:
When DTCs other than U0073/94, U0123/62, U0124/95, U0126/63 are output, inspect and repair the
trouble areas indicated by the DTCs.
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (SEE PAGE 05-2102 )
2
CHECK AND CLEAR DTCs
HINT:
When checking the DTCs for the skid control ECU, proceed to page 05-765
3
CHECK DTC COMBINATION TABLE (SEE PAGE 05-2101 )
4
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
5
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
6
REPAIR OR REPLACE
7
CONFIRMATION TEST
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2285
05-2092
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05BYM-06
LOCATION
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
Steering Sensor
Junction Connector
Yaw Rate Sensor
DLC3
G30966
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2282
05-2097
DIAGNOSTICS
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
05IR1-01
TERMINALS OF ECU
DLC3:
CG
1
2
3
4
D3
5
1.
(a)
CANH
6
7
8
DLC3
Check DLC3.
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
CANL
G25474
C81825
BAT
G26206
Standard:
Terminals
Check item
Condition
D3-6 (CANH) - D3-14 (CANL)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
54 to 69 Ω
D3-6 (CANH) - D3-16 (BAT)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 1 MΩ
D3-14 (CANL) - D3-16 (BAT)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 1 MΩ
D3-6 (CANH) - D3-4 (CG)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
D3-14 (CANL) - D3-4 (CG)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
Skid Control ECU:
CANH
G25167
CANL
GND1 +BS
2.
(a)
Specified value
SKID CONTROL ECU
Check skid control ECU.
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Disconnect the connector (S27) from the skid control ECU.
(3) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
G26428
Standard:
Terminals
Check item
Condition
Specified value
11 (CANH) - 25 (CANL)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
108 to 132 Ω
11 (CANH) - 32 (GND1)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
25 (CANL) - 32 (GND1)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
11 (CANH) - 31 (+BS)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 1 MΩ
25 (CANL) - 31 (+BS)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 1 MΩ
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2287
05-2098
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
Skid Control ECU
Connector Front
View:
S27
CANH
+BS
GND1
CANL
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Check the skid control ECU harness side connector
(S27).
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Disconnect the connector (S27) from the skid control ECU.
(3) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
E69126
Standard:
Terminals
Wiring Color
Check item
Condition
Specified value
S27-11 (CANH) - S27-25 (CANL)
B-W
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
108 to 132 Ω
S27-11 (CANH) S27-32 (GND1)
B - W-B
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
S27-25 (CANL) - S27-32 (GND1)
W - W-B
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
S27-11 (CANH) - S27-31 (+BS)
B-B
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 1 MΩ
S27-25 (CANL) - S27-31 (+BS)
W-B
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 1 MΩ
3.
(a)
Steering Sensor:
G25475
G24692
CANH CANL
BAT
STEERING SENSOR
Check steering sensor.
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Disconnect the connector (S14) from the steering
sensor.
(3) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
ESS
G26209
Standard:
Terminals
Check item
Condition
10 (CANH) - 9 (CANL)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
108 to 132 Ω
10 (CANH) - 2 (ESS)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
9 (CANL) - 2 (ESS)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
10 (CANH) - 3 (BAT)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 1 MΩ
9 (CANL) - 3 (BAT)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 1 MΩ
(b)
Steering Sensor Wire Harness View:
S14
BAT
ESS
G24991
Specified value
CANH
CANL
Check the harness side connector (S14) of the steering
sensor.
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Disconnect the connector (S14) from the steering
sensor.
(3) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
G26210
Standard:
Terminals
Wiring Color
Check item
Condition
Specified value
S14-10 (CANH) - S14-9 (CANL)
Y-W
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
108 to 132 Ω
S14-10 (CANH) - S14-2 (ESS)
Y - W-B
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
S14-9 (CANL) - S14-2 (ESS)
W - W-B
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
S14-10 (CANH) - S14-3 (BAT)
Y-P
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 1 MΩ
S14-9 (CANL) - S14-3 (BAT)
W - W-R
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 1 MΩ
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2288
05-2099
DIAGNOSTICS
Yaw Rate Sensor Connector
Front View:
4.
(a)
Y1
CANH
CANL
GND
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
YAW RATE SENSOR
Check the yaw rate sensor harness side connector (Y1).
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Disconnect the connector (Y1) from the yaw rate
sensor.
(3) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
DLC3:
D3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
BAT
G26359
G26206
G26641
Standard:
Terminals
Wiring Color
Check item
Condition
Specified value
Y1-3 (CANH) - Y1-2 (CANL)
B-W
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
54 to 69 Ω
Y1-3 (CANH) - Y1-1 (GND)
B - W-B
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
Y1-2 (CANL) - Y1-1 (GND)
W - W-B
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
Y1-3 (CANH) - D3-16 (BAT)
B-W
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 1 MΩ
Y1-2 (CANL) - D3-16 (BAT)
W-W
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 1 MΩ
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2289
05-2100
DIAGNOSTICS
5.
(a)
Junction Connector (J16):
CANH
-
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J16)
Check the junction connector.
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Disconnect the connector from the junction connector.
(3) Check the junction connector between the terminals below on the junction connector.
CANL
G26430
G25476
Standard:
Terminals
Check item
Condition
Specified value
7, 8, 9, 10, 11 (CANH) ⇔
18, 19, 20, 21, 22 (CANL)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
7, 8, 9, 10, 11 (CANH) ⇔
Body ground
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
18, 19, 20, 21, 22 (CANL) ⇔
Body ground
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
7, 8, 9, 10, 11 (CANH) ⇔ +B
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
18, 19, 20, 21, 22 (CANL) ⇔ +B
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
More than 3 kΩ
7 (CANH) ⇔ 11 (CANH)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
Less than 1 Ω
7 (CANH) ⇔ 10 (CANH)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
Less than 1 Ω
7 (CANH) ⇔ 9 (CANH)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
Less than 1 Ω
7 (CANH) ⇔ 8 (CANH)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
Less than 1 Ω
18 (CANL) ⇔ 22 (CANL)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
Less than 1 Ω
18 (CANL) ⇔ 21 (CANL)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
Less than 1 Ω
18 (CANL) ⇔ 20 (CANL)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
Less than 1 Ω
18 (CANL) ⇔ 19 (CANL)
Resistance
Ignition SW OFF
Less than 1 Ω
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2290
05-840
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CDG-11
ABS WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT (REMAINS ON)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
During DTC read by SST (CHECK WIRE), if the ABS warning light remains on, troubleshoot by following
this inspection flow.
WIRING DIAGRAM
6
IF2
W
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
29
4
R-L
IC4
S27 WA
SB
Combination Meter
13
C11
17
C11
9
IL1
SB
ABS
J6
J/C
Passenger Side J/B
4
4M
4
4J
1
4E
2
P
P
E
E
10
IC4
GR
4H
I15
Ignition SW
Instrument Panel J/B
Y
W
F7
FL Block
W
B
1
ALT
2
10
1D
ECU-IG
6
1G
IGN
1
1A
AM1
1
L-Y
AM2
10
7
1C
1
1C
6
1C
46
S27 IG1
B-R
G
4 IG1
AM1 2
GR
6 IG2
AM2 7
W
2
1
IC1
Y
W-B
32
S27 GND1
A
FL MAIN
J4
J/C
W-B
Battery
EA
EB
F46304
Author:
Date:
1030
05-841
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK DTC
Is DTC output for ABS?
Standard:
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
A
2
INSPECT CHECK IF SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR IS SECURELY
CONNECTED
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO ECU
NG
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM
OK
3
(a)
INSPECT BATTERY
Check the battery voltage.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery terminal
((+) - (-))
11 to 14 V
OK
Author:
Date:
1031
05-842
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU TERMINAL VOLTAGE(IG1 TERMINAL)
WHEN USING HAND-HELD TESTER:
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Start the engine.
(c) Select the DATA LIST mode on the hand-held tester.
(d) Read the voltage condition output from the ECU displayed on the hand-held tester.
Item
IG VOLTAGE
Measurement Item /
Range (Display)
ECU power supply voltage /
TOO LOW / NORMAL
Normal Condition
NORMAL: 9.5 V or over
TOO LOW: Below 9.5 V
OK:
”Normal” is displayed.
WHEN NOT USING HAND-HELD TESTER:
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
GND1
IG1
G24767
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-46 (IG1) - S27-32 (GND1)
11 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
Author:
Date:
1032
05-843
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION
METER)
(a)
Skid Control ECU Front View
WA
S27
(b)
(c)
Combination Meter
(harness side view)
C11
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and combination meter connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C11-17 - S27-29 (WA)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-29 (WA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
F46286
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
6
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-32 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
GND1
G24767
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1033
05-854
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05F1V-09
BRAKE WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The BRAKE warning light comes on when the brake fluid is insufficient, the parking brake is applied or the
EBD is defective.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
13
C11
11
B
C12
10
C12
Brake
SB
2
P
1
28
S27 PKB
R-W
P
E
R
1
IC4
R-B
J6
J/C
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
44
16
LG-B
IC4
S27 BRL
15
IF3
V
B4
Brake Warning SW
9
IL1
SB
6
IF3
W-B
E
Passenger Side J/B
4
4M
1
4E
Y
1
1C
GR
6
IG2
1
IC1
3
4J
9
4M
6
1G
IGN
LG
Passenger Side J/B
Instrument Panel J/B
I15
Ignition SW
7 AM2
11
IC4
W
F7
FL Block
L-Y
B
10
AM2
1
W
FL MAIN
Battery
A
J4
J/C
EB
P3
Parking
Brake SW
1
F50610
Author:
Date:
1044
05-855
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
When releasing the parking brake, set the chocks to hold the vehicle for safety.
1
(a)
(b)
CHECK BRAKE FLUID
Release the parking brake pedal.
Check that the brake fluid level is proper.
NG
ADD BRAKE FLUID
OK
2
(a)
CHECK DTC FOR ABS
Are the DTC recorded? (see page 05-765 )
NO
Go to step 3
YES
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT CODE
3
INSPECT BRAKE WARNING LIGHT
WHEN USING HAND-HELD TESTER:
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Start the engine.
(c) Select the item ”BRAKE WARN LIGHT” in the ACTIVE TEST and operate the BRAKE warning light
on the hand-held tester.
Item
BRAKE WRN LIGHT
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Turns BRAKE warning light ON / OFF
Diagnostic Note
Observe combination meter
(d)
Check that ”ON” and ”OFF” of the BRAKE warning light are indicated on the combination meter when
using the hand-held tester.
OK:
Turn the BRAKE warning light on or off in accordance with the hand-held tester.
WHEN NOT USING HAND-HELD TESTER:
Skid Control ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch off and disconnect the connector
(harness side connector) S27
from the skid control ECU.
(b) Ground terminal BRL of the skid control ECU.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Check that the brake warning light.
OK:
Turn the light on or off in accordance with the connecBRL
tion of terminal BRL and body ground.
G24767
NG
Go to step 4
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1045
05-856
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSY
Parking Brake Switch
Release
Push
(a)
(b)
Remove the parking brake switch connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
P3
G26238
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
P3-1 - Ground part
Released
Below 1 Ω
P3-1 - Ground part
Pushed in
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSY
OK
5
CHECK HARNESS OR CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL ECU - PARKING BRAKE
SWITCH)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
(a)
PKB
Parking Brake Switch
(harness side connector)
(b)
(c)
P3
PKB
G26243
G26242
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and the parking brake switch connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-28 (PKB) - P3-1 (PKB)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-28 (PKB) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
6
INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(a)
(b)
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
B4
(c)
G26237
Remove the reservoir tank cap and strainer.
Disconnect the brake fluid level warning switch connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
(B4-1) - (B4-2)
Float UP
10 kΩ or higher
(B4-1) - (B4-2)
Float DOWN
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING
SWITCH
OK
Author:
Date:
1046
05-857
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS OR CONNECTOR(BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH COMBINATION METER)
(a)
Combination Meter
(harness side view)
(b)
C12
(c)
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
(harness side connector)
Disconnect the combination meter connector and the
brake fluid level warning switch connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
(C12-10) - (B4-1)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
(C12-10) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
B4
NG
I37939
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
Author:
Date:
1047
05-858
DIAGNOSTICS
8
S27
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS OR CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION
METER)
(a)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector)
(b)
(c)
BRL
Combination Meter
(harness side view)
C12
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and combination meter connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-44 (BRL) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
F46287
Tester Connection
S27-44 (BRL) - (C12-3)
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1048
05-844
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05F1T-06
ABS WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT (DOES NOT LIGHT UP)
WIRING DIAGRAM
6
IF2
W
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
29
4
R-L
IC4
S27 WA
SB
Combination Meter
13
C11
17
C11
9
IL1
SB
ABS
J6
J/C
Passenger Side J/B
4
4M
4
4J
1
4E
2
P
P
E
E
10
IC4
GR
4H
I15
Ignition SW
Instrument Panel J/B
Y
W
F7
FL Block
W
B
1
ALT
2
10
1D
ECU-IG
6
1G
IGN
1
1A
AM1
1
L-Y
AM2
10
7
1C
1
1C
6
1C
46
S27 IG1
B-R
G
4 IG1
AM1 2
GR
6 IG2
AM2 7
W
2
1
IC1
Y
W-B
32
S27 GND1
A
FL MAIN
J4
J/C
W-B
Battery
EA
EB
F46304
Author:
Date:
1034
05-845
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT ABS WARNING LIGHT
WHEN USING HAND-HELD TESTER:
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 and start the engine.
(b) Select the item ”ABS WARN LIGHT” in the ACTIVE TEST and operate the ABS warning light on the
hand-held tester.
Item
ABS WARN LIGHT
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Turns ABS warning light ON / OFF
Diagnostic Note
Observe combination meter
(c)
Check that ”ON” and ”OFF” of the ABS warning light can be shown on the combination meter by the
hand-held tester.
OK:
Turn the ABS warning light ON or OFF in accordance with the hand-held tester.
WHEN NOT USING HAND-HELD TESTER:
Skid Control ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch off and disconnect the connector
(harness side connector) S27
from the skid control ECU.
(b) Ground terminal WA of the skid control ECU.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Check that the ABS warning light.
OK:
Turn the light ON or OFF in accordance with the conWA
necting condition of terminal WA and body ground.
G24767
NG
CHECK AND REPAIR ABS WARNING LIGHT
CIRCUIT
OK
Author:
Date:
1035
05-846
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION
METER)
(a)
Skid Control ECU Front View
S27
WA
(b)
(c)
Combination Meter
(harness side view)
C11
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and combination meter connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-29 (WA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
F46286
Tester Connection
C11-17 - S27-29 (WA)
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1036
05-788
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05F1P-08
DTC
C0200/31 RIGHT FRONT SPEED SENSOR
DTC
C0205/32 LEFT FRONT SPEED SENSOR
DTC
C1235/35 FOREIGN MATTER IS ATTACHED ON TIP OF
RIGHT FRONT SENSOR
DTC
C1236/36 FOREIGN MATTER IS ATTACHED ON TIP OF
LEFT FRONT SENSOR
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Rotor
The speed sensor detects wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are used to control
the ABS control system. The front and rear rotors have 48
serrations each.
When the rotors rotate, the magnetic field emitted by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor generates AC voltage. Since
the frequency of this AC voltage changes in direct proportion to
the speed of the rotor, the frequency is used by the ECU to detect the speed of each wheel.
Speed Sensor
S Magnet
N
Coil
To ECU
Low Speed
High Speed
+V
BR3583
BR3582
-V
DTC No.
F00010
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
C0200/31
C0205/32
(1) All the following conditions continues for at least 1 second.
Vehicle speed is more than 6 mph (10 km/h).
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor signal circuit of
faulty wheel continues for 1 second or more.
(2) Momentary interruption of the sensor signal of faulty
wheel has occurred 7 times or more.
(3) Sensor signal circuit is open for 0.5 seconds.
Right front and left front speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor rotor
Sensor installation
C1235/35
C1236/36
All the following conditions for at least 5 seconds.
Vehicle speed is more than 12 mph (20 km/h).
Vehicle speed sensor signal receives.
Right front and left front speed sensor
Each speed sensor
Sensor installation
HINT:
DTC C0200/31 and C1235/35 are for the right front speed sensor.
DTC C0205/32 and C1236/36 are for the left front speed sensor.
Author:
Date:
978
05-789
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
2
A5
ABS Speed Sensor
Front RH
1
R-Y
3
S27 FR+
LG
17
S27 FR-
O
18
S27 FL+
P
4
S27 FL-
2
A4
ABS Speed Sensor
Front LH
1
F40566
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the hand-held tester and start from step 3 when not using the
hand-held tester.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER(FRONT SPEED SENSOR)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Select the DATA LIST mode on the hand-held tester.
Check that there is no difference between the speed value output from the speed sensor displayed
on the hand-held tester and the speed value displayed on the speedometer when driving the vehicle.
Item
WHEEL SPD FR
WHEEL SPD FL
Measurement Item /
Range (Display)
Wheel speed sensor (FR) reading /
min.: 0 km/h (0 MPH, max.: 326 km/h
(202 MPH)
Wheel speed sensor (FL) reading /
min.: 0 km/h (0 MPH, max.: 326 km/h
(202 MPH)
Normal Condition
Actual wheel speed
Actual wheel speed
OK:
There is almost no difference from the displayed speed value.
HINT:
There is tolerance of ± 10 % in the speedometer indication.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
Author:
Date:
979
05-790
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR ROTOR SERRATIONS
Normal Signal Waveform
GND
2 m/s / Division
1 V / Division
W04200
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
(a) Connect the oscilloscope to terminal FR+ - FR- or FL+
- FL- of the skid control ECU.
(b) Drive the vehicle at about 19 mph (30 km/h), and check
the signal waveform.
OK:
A waveform as shown in a figure should be output.
HINT:
As the vehicle speed (wheel revolution speed) increases,
a cycle of the waveform narrows and the fluctuation in the
output voltage becomes greater.
When noise is identified in the waveform on the oscilloscope, error signals are generated due to the speed sensor rotor’s scratches, looseness or foreign matter attached to it.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
980
05-791
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT FRONT SPEED SENSOR
(a)
2
A4
(b)
(c)
1
A5
Make sure that there is no looseness at the connectors’
locking part and connecting part of connector.
Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
LH:
Front Speed Sensor
C93876
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A4-1 (FL-) - A4-2 (FL+)
0.6 to 2.5 kΩ
RH:
(d)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-1 (FR-) - A5-2 (FR+)
0.6 to 2.5 kΩ
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
LH:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A4-1 (FL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A4-2 (FL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
RH:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-1 (FR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A5-2 (FR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after replacement
(see page 05-765 ).
NG
REPLACE FRONT SPEED SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-40 )
OK
Author:
Date:
981
05-792
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(FRONT SPEED SENSOR - SKID CONTROL
ECU)
(a)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
FR+
FL-
(b)
FL+
FRFront Speed Sensor
(harness side connector)
A5
A4
FL-
FL+
FR-
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and the front
speed sensor connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
LH:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-18 (FL+) - A4-2 (FL+)
Below 1 Ω
S27-4 (FL-) - A4-1 (FL-)
Below 1 Ω
RH:
FR+
G26177
(c)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-3 (FR+) - A5-2 (FR+)
Below 1 Ω
S27-17 (FR-) - A5-1 (FR-)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
LH:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-18 (FL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S27-4 (FL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
RH:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-3 (FR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S27-17 (FR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
Author:
Date:
982
05-793
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR ROTOR SERRATIONS
Normal Signal Waveform
GND
2 m/s / Division
1 V / Division
W04200
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
(a) Connect the oscilloscope to terminal FR+ - FR- or FL+
- FL- of the skid control ECU.
(b) Drive the vehicle at about 19 mph (30 km/h), and check
the signal waveform.
OK:
A waveform as shown in a figure should be output.
HINT:
As the vehicle speed (wheel revolution speed) increases,
a cycle of the waveform narrows and the fluctuation in the
output voltage becomes greater.
When noise is identified in the waveform on the oscilloscope, error signals are generated due to the speed sensor rotor’s scratches, looseness or foreign matter attached to it.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
6
INSPECT FRONT SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
(a)
Speed Sensor
8.0 N⋅m
(82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
No Clearance
OK
NG
BR3795
Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
The installation bolt is tightened properly.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
There is no clearance between the sensor and the
front steering knuckle.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after the replacement
(see page 05-765 ).
NG
REPLACE FRONT SPEED SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-40 )
OK
Author:
Date:
983
05-794
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR TIP
(a)
(b)
Remove the front speed sensor (see page 32-40 ).
Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign matter on the sensor tip.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after the replacement (see page 05-765 ).
NG
CLEAN OR REPAIR SPEED SENSOR
OK
8
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR ROTOR
(a)
(b)
Speed Sensor Rotor
R00948
Remove the front speed sensor rotor.
Check the sensor rotor serrations.
OK:
No scratches, missing teeth or foreign matter on the
rotors.
HINT:
If there is foreign matter in the rotor, remove it and check the
output waveform after reassembly.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after the replacement
(see page 05-765 ).
NG
CLEAN OR REPAIR SPEED SENSOR ROTOR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
984
05-795
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05H3B-03
DTC
C0210/33 RIGHT REAR SPEED SENSOR
DTC
C0215/34 LEFT REAR SPEED SENSOR
DTC
C1238/38 FOREIGN MATTER IS ATTACHED ON TIP OF
RIGHT REAR SENSOR
DTC
C1239/39 FOREIGN MATTER IS ATTACHED ON TIP OF
LEFT REAR SENSOR
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC C0200/31, C0205/32, C1235/35, C1236/36 on page 05-788 .
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
C0210/33
C0215/34
(1) All the following conditions continues for at least 1 second.
Vehicle speed is more than 6 mph (10 km/h).
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor signal circuit of
faulty wheel continues for 1 second or more.
(2) Momentary interruption of the sensor signal of faulty
wheel has occurred 7 times or more.
(3) Sensor signal circuit is open for 0.5 seconds.
Right rear and left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor rotor
Sensor installation
C1238/38
C1239/39
All the following conditions for at least 5 seconds.
Vehicle speed is more than 12 mph (20 km/h).
Vehicle speed sensor signal receives.
Right rear and left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor
Sensor installation
HINT:
DTC C0210/33 and C1238/38 are for the right rear speed sensor.
DTC C0215/34 and C1239/39 are for the left rear speed sensor.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
V
12
IA1
O
16
IC2
G
6
S27 RL-
R
2
IA1
Y
7
IC2
Y-G
20
S27 RL+
P
2
IO2
R
15
IC2
BR
19
S27 RR-
GR
1
IO2
L
6
IC2
Y
5
S27 RR+
A24
ABS Speed Sensor
Rear LH
2
1
A25
ABS Speed Sensor
Rear RH
2
1
F46312
Author:
Date:
985
05-796
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the hand-held tester and start from step 3 when not using the
hand-held tester.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER(REAR SPEED SENSOR)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Select the DATA LIST mode on the hand-held tester.
Check that there is no difference between the speed value output from the speed sensor displayed
by the hand-held tester and the speed value displayed on the speedometer when driving the vehicle.
Item
WHEEL SPD RL
WHEEL SPD RR
Measurement Item /
Range (Display)
Wheel speed sensor (RL) reading /
min.: 0 km/h (0 MPH, max.: 326 km/h
(202 MPH)
Wheel speed sensor (RR) reading /
min.: 0 km/h (0 MPH, max.: 326 km/h
(202 MPH)
Normal Condition
Actual wheel speed
Actual wheel speed
OK:
There is almost no difference in the displayed speed value.
HINT:
There is tolerance of ± 10 % in the speedometer indication.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR ROTOR SERRATIONS
Normal Signal Waveform
GND
2 m/s / Division
1 V / Division
W04200
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
(a) Connect the oscilloscope to terminals RR+ - RR- or RL+
- RL- of the skid control ECU.
(b) Drive the vehicle at approximately 19 mph (30 km/h), and
check the signal waveform.
OK:
A waveform as shown in a figure should be output.
HINT:
As the vehicle speed (wheel revolution speed) increases,
a cycle of the waveform narrows and the fluctuation in the
output voltage becomes greater.
When noise is identified in the waveform on the oscilloscope, error signals are generated due to the speed sensor rotor’s scratches, looseness or foreign matter attached to it.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
REPLACE REAR SPEED SENSOR (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
986
05-797
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT REAR SPEED SENSOR
2WD:
(a) Disconnect the skid control sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Rear Speed Sensor
1
2
(c)
F41836
Connector B
1
2
1
Connector A
2
F10180
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
0.9 to 2.1 kΩ
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
2WD:
Skid control sensor sub-wire harness:
(a) Remove the seat cushion and seatback.
(b) Make sure that there is no looseness at the connector’s
locking part and connecting part of the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between terminal 1 of connector
A and terminal 2 of connector B.
(d) Measure the resistance between terminal 2 of connector
A and terminal 1 of connector B.
Standard:
(e)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A-1 - B-1
1 Ω or less
A-2 - B-2
1 Ω or less
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed
sensor connector A and body ground.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Author:
Date:
987
05-798
DIAGNOSTICS
1
2
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
4WD:
(a) Disconnect the rear speed sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
(c)
R14205
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
0.9 to 1.3 kΩ at 25 C
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after replacement
(see page 05-765 ).
NG
REPLACE REAR SPEED SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-37 )
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(REAR SPEED SENSOR - SKID CONTROL
ECU)
(a)
Skid Control ECU
S27
(harness side connector)
RR+
RL-
(b)
RL+
RRSkid Control Sensor
(harness side connector)
A24
RL-
A25
RL+
RR-
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and the skid
control sensor connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
LH:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-20 (RL+) - A24-1 (RL+)
Below 1 Ω
S27-6 (RL-) - A24-2 (RL-)
Below 1 Ω
RH:
RR+
G26241
(c)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-5 (RR+) - A25-1 (RR+)
Below 1 Ω
S27-19 (RR-) - A25-2 (RR-)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
LH:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-20 (RL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S27-6 (RL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
RH:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-5 (RR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S27-19 (RR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Author:
Date:
988
05-799
DIAGNOSTICS
NG
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
5
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR ROTOR SERRATIONS
Normal Signal Waveform
GND
2 m/s / Division
1 V / Division
W04200
INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
(a) Connect the oscilloscope to terminals RR+ - RR- or RL+
- RL- of the skid control ECU.
(b) Drive the vehicle at approximately 19 mph (30 km/h), and
check the signal waveform.
OK:
A waveform as shown in a figure should be output.
HINT:
As the vehicle speed (wheel revolution speed) increases,
a cycle of the waveform narrows and the fluctuation in the
output voltage becomes greater.
When noise is identified in the waveform on the oscilloscope, error signals are generated due to the speed sensor rotor’s scratches, looseness or foreign matter attached to it.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
REPLACE REAR SPEED SENSOR (SEE PAGE 32-42 (FF) OR 32-44 (4WD))
Author:
Date:
989
05-800
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT REAR SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
2WD:
(a) Check the sensor installation.
OK:
There is no clearance between the sensor and rear
axle carrier.
Skid Control Sensor
OK
NG
F10178
8.0 N⋅m
(82 kgf⋅cm,71 in.⋅lbf)
No Clearnace
OK
NG
BR3795
4WD:
(a) Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
There is no clearance between the sensor and rear
axle carrier.
The installation bolt is tightened properly.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after replacement
(see page 05-765 ).
NG
REPLACE REAR SPEED SENSOR
(SEE PAGE 32-42 (FF) OR 32-44 (4WD))
OK
Author:
Date:
990
05-801
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR ROTOR AND SENSOR TIP
2WD:
(a) Remove the skid control sensor (see page 32-42 ).
(b) Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign matter on the sensor tip.
4WD:
(a) Remove the rear speed sensor (See page 32-44 ).
(b) Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign matter on the sensor tip.
Sensor Rotor
2WD:
(a) Check the sensor rotor serrations.
OK:
No scratches, missing teeth or foreign matter on the
rotor.
F08575
Sensor Rotor
R00948
4WD:
(a) Remove the rear drive shaft (See page 30-45 ).
(b) Check the sensor rotor serrations.
OK:
No scratches, missing teeth or foreign matter.
HINT:
If foreign matter is attached, remove it and after reassembling,
check the output waveform.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after the replacement
(see page 05-765 ).
NG
CLEAN OR REPLACE SPEED SENSOR AND
SENSOR ROTOR SERRATIONS
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
991
05-802
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
DTC
C0226/21 SFR SOLENOID CIRCUIT
DTC
C0236/22 SFL SOLENOID CIRCUIT
DTC
C0246/23 SRR SOLENOID CIRCUIT
DTC
C0256/24 SRL SOLENOID CIRCUIT
DTC
C1225/25 SMC SOLENOID CIRCUIT
05CDP-15
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This solenoid goes on when signals are received from the ECU and controls the pressure acting on the wheel
cylinders to control the braking force.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
C0226/21
Open or short circuit in front right solenoid circuit (SFRR or
SFRH) continues for 0.05 sec. or more.
ABS & TRAC actuator
Each solenoid circuit
C0236/22
Open or short circuit in front left solenoid circuit (SFLR or
SFLH) continues for 0.05 sec. or more.
ABS & TRAC actuator
Each solenoid circuit
C0246/23
Open or short circuit in rear right solenoid circuit (SRRR or
SRRH) continues for 0.05 sec. or more.
ABS & TRAC actuator
Each solenoid circuit
C0256/24
Open or short circuit in rear left solenoid circuit (SRLR or
SRLH) continues for 0.05 sec. or more.
ABS & TRAC actuator
Each solenoid circuit
C1225/25
When any of the following (1 to 5) is detected:
(1) All the following conditions continues for at least 0.05
seconds.
When switching solenoid (SM1 or SM2) outputs ON signal.
Over current.
(2) All the following conditions continues for at least 0.05
seconds.
When switching solenoid (SM1 or SM2) outputs OFF signal.
Open circuit.
(3) All the following conditions continues for at least 0.05
seconds.
When switching solenoid (SM1 or SM2) outputs OFF signal.
Output current monitor is more than 0.15 A.
(4) All the following conditions continues for at least 0.05
seconds.
When switching solenoid (SM1 or SM2) outputs ON signal.
Output current is more than 0.348 A.
Difference between current monitor and target value exceeds 2, continues for between 0.1 sec. and 0.15 sec.
(5) All the following conditions continues for at least 0.2
seconds.
When switching solenoid (SM1 or SM2) outputs ON signal.
Output current is more than 0.348 A.
1. More than 2.08
2. Less than 0.48
ABS & TRAC actuator
Each solenoid circuit
Author:
Date:
992
05-803
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
F7
FL Block
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
W
31
S27 +BS
B
1
ABS1
8
W-B
32
S27 GND1
A
J4
J/C
FL MAIN
W-B
Battery
EA
EB
F46309
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
RECONFIRM DTC
HINT:
This code is detected when a problem is determined in the brake actuator assy.
The solenoid circuit is in the brake actuator assy.
Therefore, solenoid circuit inspection and solenoid unit inspection cannot be performed. Be sure to check
if the DTC code is output before replacing the brake actuator assy.
(a) Clear the DTCs(see page 05-765 ).
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Are the same DTCs recorded?
NO
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-786 ).
YES
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
993
05-804
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05F1Q-09
DTC
C0273/13 OPEN CIRCUIT IN ABS MOTOR RELAY
CIRCUIT
DTC
C0274/14 SHORT CIRCUIT IN ABS MOTOR RELAY
CIRCUIT
DTC
C1361/91 SHORT CIRCUIT IN ABS MOTOR FAIL SAFE
RELAY CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The VSC motor relays consist of 2 relays are included in the ABS R/B.
The VSC cut relay is turned on after turning the ignition switch to the ON position. If the DTCs in the
ABS pump motor circuit are memorized, the VSC cut relay cuts off the power supply to the VSC motor
relay and performs the fail safe.
While any of the ABS, BA, TRAC and VSC is operating, the skid control ECU (included in the actuator)
turns the VSC motor relay on to operate the actuator pump motor.
If the voltage applied to the VSC motor relays (+BM) drops below the condition that detects the DTCs
due to the shortage of the battery or alternator output, the DTCs may be memorized.
DTC No.
C0273/13
C0274/14
C1361/91
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When any of the following (1 to 2) is detected:
(1) All the following conditions continues for at least 0.2
seconds.
IG1 voltage is between 9.5 and 17.2 V.
During initial check.
ABS, BA, TRAC, and VSC are in operation.
Relay contact is open when the relay is ON.
(2) All the following conditions continues for at least 0.2
seconds.
IG1 voltage is less than 9.5 V.
Relay contact remains open when the relay is ON.
ABS No.2 fuse
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR relay circuit
ABS R/B
ABS cut relay
ABS cut relay circuit
The following condition continue for at least 4 seconds.
Relay contact is closed when the relay is OFF.
ABS No.2 fuse
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR relay circuit
ABS R/B
ABS cut relay
ABS cut relay circuit
All the following conditions continues for at least 4 seconds.
Immediately after turning IG switch to the ON position.
Relay contact is closed when fail-safe relay is OFF.
ABS No.2 fuse
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR relay circuit
ABS R/B
ABS cut relay
ABS cut relay circuit
Author:
Date:
994
05-805
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
B-O
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
45
S27 R+
ABS R/B
ABS MTR Relay
B-O
B
5
5
1
2
5
3
LG
5
W-L
5
15
S27 MR
2
S27 BM
ABS CUT Relay
5
5
FL MAIN
5
3
1
B-R
5
G-R
5
2
14
S27 MRF
F7
FL Block
W
1
ABS2
9
Battery
F46308
Author:
Date:
995
05-806
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the hand-held tester and start from step 2 when not using the
hand-held tester.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY HAND-HELD TESTER(ABS MOTOR RELAY
OPERATION)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the hand-held tester.
Check the operation sound of the ABS motor individually when operating it with the hand-held tester.
Item
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
ABS MOT RELAY
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
ABS motor relay / ON or OFF
ON : Motor relay ON
OK:
The operation sound of the ABS motor should be heard.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
2
INSPECT FUSE(ABS2 FUSE)
(a)
(b)
FL BLOCK
Remove ABS2 fuse from the FL BLOCK.
Check continuity of ABS2 fuse.
Standard:
ABS No.1 fuse
NG
ABS2
F40458
Below 1Ω (Continuity)
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR CONNECTED TO FUSE AND
REPLACE FUSE
OK
Author:
Date:
996
05-807
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK TERMINAL VOLTAGE(VSC MOTOR RELAY 5 TERMINAL OF ABS R/B)
(a)
(b)
(c)
ABS R/B:
5
Remove the VSC MTR relay from the ABS R/B.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Terminals 5 - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
I37487
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
4
INSPECT VSC MOTOR RELAY
(a)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
3-5
3-5
B57491
NG
Connection
Specified resistance
Always
10 kΩ or higher (No continuity)
Apply B+ between terminal 1 and 2
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE VSC MOTOR RELAY
OK
5
INSPECT VSC CUT RELAY
(a)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Connection
Specified resistance
3-5
Always
10 kΩ or higher (No continuity)
3-5
B16200
NO
Apply B+ between terminal 1 and 2
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE VSC CUT RELAY
OK
Author:
Date:
997
05-808
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(VSC MOTOR RELAY - SKID CONTROL
ECU)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector)
BM
(a)
(b)
S27
(c)
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-2 (BM) - 3 (ABS R/B)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
ABS R/B:
NG
3
I37488
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-2 BM - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(VSC MOTOR RELAY - SKID CONTROL
RELAY)
(a)
ABS R/B:
5
(b)
Remove the ABS motor relay and skid control relay from
ABS R/B.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
3
I37487
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
5 (ABS MOTOR Relay) 3 (Skid Control Relay)
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
998
05-809
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CD5-19
DTC
C0278/11 OPEN CIRCUIT IN ABS SOLENOID RELAY
CIRCUIT
DTC
C0279/12 SHORT CIRCUIT IN ABS SOLENOID RELAY
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ABS solenoid relay is built in the ABS & TRACTION Actuator assy. This relay supplies power to each
ABS solenoid. If the initial check is OK, after the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, the relay goes
on.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
C0278/11
When any of the following (1 to 2) is detected:
(1) All the following conditions continues for at least 0.2
seconds.
IG voltage is between 9.5 and 17.2 V.
Relay contact is open when the relay is ON.
(2) All the following conditions continues for at least 0.2
seconds.
IG voltage is 9.5 V or less when the relay is ON.
Relay contact remains open.
ABS No.1 fuse
ABS SOL relay
ABS SOL relay circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
C0279/12
The following condition continue for at least 0.2 seconds.
Relay contact is closed immediately after turning IG switch
to the ON position when the relay is OFF.
ABS No.1 fuse
ABS SOL relay
ABS SOL relay circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
WIRING DIAGRAM
F7
FL Block
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
W
31
S27 +BS
B
1
ABS1
8
W-B
32
S27 GND1
A
J4
J/C
FL MAIN
W-B
Battery
EA
EB
F46309
Author:
Date:
999
05-810
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE(ABS1 FUSE)
(a)
(b)
FL BLOCK
Remove ABS1 fuse from the FL BLOCK.
Check continuity of ABS1 fuse.
Standard:
ABS No.2 fuse
NG
ABS1
F40458
Below 1 Ω (Continuity)
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR CONNECTED TO FUSE AND
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR(+BS TERMINAL VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Skid Control ECU S27
(harness side connector)
GND1
+BS
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-31 (+BS) - S27-32 (GND1)
10 to 14 V
NG
Go to step 4
G24767
OK
3
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page 05-765 ).
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Are the same DTCs recorded?
NOTICE:
When replacing ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY, perform zero point calibration
(see page 05-765 ).
NO
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-786 )
YES
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1000
05-81 1
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR(GND TERMINAL CONTINUITY)
(a)
(b)
Skid Control ECU S27
(harness side connector)
GND1
G24767
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-32 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
5
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page 05-765 ).
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Are the same DTCs recorded? (see page 05-765 ).
HINT:
It is suspect that the DTCs output was caused by the poor connection of the connector terminal.
NO
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-786 )
YES
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1001
05-812
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CD6-06
C1201/51 ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If trouble occurs in the engine control system, the skid control ECU prohibits TRAC and VSC control.
DTC No.
C1201/51
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
At the engine speed of 500 rpm, a trouble signal in the engine control system continues for 5 secs. or more.
Engine control system
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK DTC FOR ENGINE
Check if the normal code is recorded for SFI system.
A
Normal System Code
B
Trouble Code
B
REPAIR
ENGINE
CONTROL
ACCORDING TO DTC OUTPUT
SYSTEM
A
REPLACE ECM
Author:
Date:
1002
05-813
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CDQ-14
C1203/53 ECM COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The circuit is used to send TRAC & VSC control information from the skid control ECU to the ECM (TRC+,
TRC-), and engine control information from the ECM to the skid control ECU (ENG+, ENG-).
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
C1203/53
When any of the following (1 to 3) is detected:
(1) All the following conditions continues for at least 5 seconds.
IG1 terminal voltage is 9.5 V or more.
Cannot send data to ECM.
(2) All the following conditions continues for at least 5 seconds.
IG1 terminal voltage is more than 9.5 V.
Engine speed is 500 rpm or more.
Cannot receive data from ECM.
(2) All the following conditions repeats 10 times in a series.
Cannot send data to ECM.
Cannot receive data from ECM.
Both of the above occur at least once within 5 sec.
TRC+ or TRC- circuit
ENG+ or ENG- circuit
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
ECM
24
ENG+ E5
V
5
IC4
W-L
9
S27 ENG+
30
E5
R
18
IC4
W-G
23
S27 ENG-
25
TRC+ E5
Y
7
IC4
G-B
8
S27 TRC+
31
E5
G
19
IC4
Y-B
22
S27 TRC-
ENG-
TRC-
F46313
Author:
Date:
1003
05-814
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(ECM - SKID CONTROL ECU)
S27
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector)
(a)
ENG+
(b)
TRC+
TRC-
ENG-
ECM
(c)
E5
ENG+
TRC+
TRC-
F44428
F45165
ENGF45351
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and ECM
connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-8 (TRC+) - E5-25 (TRC+)
Below 1 Ω
S27-22 (TRC-) - E5-31 (TRC-)
Below 1 Ω
S27-9 (ENG+) - E5-24 (ENG+)
Below 1 Ω
S27-23 (ENG-) - E5-30 (ENG-)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-8 (TRC+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S27-22 (TRC-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S27-9 (ENG+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S27-23 (ENG-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2
ECM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(E1 OF ECM - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
E7
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
E1
G26183
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-1 (E1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1004
05-815
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05F1R-07
DTC
C1210/36 ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF YAW RATE
SENSOR UNDONE
DTC
C1336/39 ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF
DECELERATION SENSOR UNDONE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Brake actuator receives signals from the yaw rate sensor (deceleration sensor) via CAN communication system.
Yaw rate sensor has the built-in G sensor.
If there is trouble in the bus lines between the yaw rate sensor (deceleration sensor) and CAN communication system, the DTC U0123/62 (yaw rate sensor communication trouble) and U0124/95 (G sensor communication trouble) are output.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
C1210/36
Zero point calibration of yaw rate sensor undone
Yaw rate sensor (Deceleration sensor)
Zero point calibration undone
(Perform zero point calibration and DTC.
If DTC is not output again, the sensor is normal)
C1336/39
When all the following (1 to 2) is detected:
(1) Drives in normal mode before completing zero point
calibration.
(2) Zero point voltage is not within 2.38 V and 2.62 V at
zero point calibration.
Yaw rate sensor (Deceleration sensor)
Zero point calibration undone
(If DTC is not output again, the sensor is normal)
Author:
Date:
1005
05-816
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
When U0121/94, U0123/62, U0124/95 or U0126/63 are output accompanied with C1210/36 or C1336/39,
inspect and repair the trouble areas indicated by U0121/94, U0123/62, U0124/95 or U0126/63 first.
1
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF YAW RATE SENSOR AND
DECELERATION SENSOR
Perform the zero point calibration of the yaw rate sensor and deceleration sensor
(see page 05-765 ).
NEXT
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
RECONFIRM DTC
Clear the DTCs (see page 05-765 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Are the same DTCs recorded? (see page 05-765 ).
NO
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-786 )
YES
3
(a)
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION
Check that the yaw rate sensor has been installed properly (see page 32-46 ).
NG
INSTALL YAW RATE SENSOR CORRECTLY
OK
REPLACE YAWRATE SENSOR(SEE PAGE 32-46 )
Author:
Date:
1006
05-817
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CD8-07
C1223/43 ABS CONTROL SYSTEM MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
HINT:
This DTC is output when the VSC system detects a malfunction in the ABS system.
When DTC C1223/43 is memorized, there is no malfunction in the skid control ECU.
DTC No.
C1223/43
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Malfunction in ABS control system
ABS control system
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK DTC(FOR ABS SYSTEM)
Clear the DTCs (see page 05-765 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Are the same DTCs recorded? (see page 05-765 )
NO
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE
PAGE 05-786 )
YES
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT DTC
Author:
Date:
1007
05-818
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CD9-17
C1224/44 NE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU receives engine revolution speed signals (NE signals) from the ECM.
DTC No.
C1224/44
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When any of the following (1 to 2) is detected:
(1) Any of the following conditions continues for at least 10
seconds.
Data can be received properly from ECM at a speed of
more than 19 mph (30 km/h).
Open or short in engine rpm signal circuit.
(2) Any of the following conditions continues for at least
0.24 seconds.
TRAC is in operation.
Open or short in engine rpm signal circuit.
NEO circuit
ECM
Skid control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
ECM
17
NEO E5
B
3
IC4
V
10
S27 NEO
F46314
Author:
Date:
1008
05-819
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL ECU - ECM)
(a)
Skid Control ECU
S27
(harness side connector)
NEO
(b)
(c)
ECM
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and the ECM
connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-10 (NEO) - E5-17 (NEO)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
E5
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-10 (NEO) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NEO
G26436
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
Author:
Date:
1009
05-820
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT ECM TERMINAL VOLTAGE(NEO TERMINAL)
(a)
ECM
Reconnect the ECM connector and the skid control ECU
connector.
Check the signal waveform between terminal NEO
(E5-17) of the ECM and body ground for the engine
conditions below.
OK:
E5
(b)
NEO
G26185
Tester Connection
Engine Condition
Specified condition
E5-17 (NEO) - Body
ground
OFF (Ignition switch ON)
4.5 to 14 V or below 1 V
E5-17 (NEO) - Body
ground
ON (Idling)
Pulse generation
(4.5 to 14 V ↔ below 1 V)
Pulse
Generation
20 V/DIV, 1 ms/DIV
4.5 to 14 V
Below 1 V
A20293
NG
REPLACE ECM
OK
3
CHECK IF SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR IS SECURELY CONNECTED
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO ECU
OK
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
RECONFIRM DTC
Clear the DTCs (see page 05-765 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Are the same DTCs recorded?
NO
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-786 )
YES
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY(SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1010
05-821
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CDA-18
C1231/31 MALFUNCTION IN STEERING ANGLE
SENSOR CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The steering angle sensor signal is sent to the skid control ECU through the CAN communication system.
When there is a malfunction in the communication, it will be detected by the diagnosis function.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
C1231/31
When ECU IG1 terminal voltage is 9.5 V or more, the steering angle sensor malfunction signal is received.
Trouble Area
Steering angle sensor
Steering angle sensor circuit
+B circuit
CAN communication system
Author:
Date:
1011
05-822
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
S14
Steering Sensor
CANL
CANH
J16
J/C
W
13
IC4
12
IC4
W
9
21
19
10
8
L
Y
10
W
B
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
25
S27 CANL
11
S27 CANH
Passenger Side J/B
ESS
3
4C
W-B
2
J17
J/C
BAT
IG1
9
1D
P
E
E
10
1G
Passenger Side J/B
11
4
4C
4J
L
1
I15
Ignition SW
W-B
BR
5
IC3
Y
Instrument Panel J/B
G
7
1C
ECU-IG
10
1D
W
6
1C
AM1
1
1A
IG1 4
2 AM1
W-B
Instrument Panel J/B
P
3
1
4N
7
4L
2
F7 FL Block
1
B
W
1
ALT
2
Engine Room J/B
FL
MAIN
W
3
1
2I
D.C.C
ECU-B
4
2A
W-L
IC
Battery
F46318
Author:
Date:
1012
05-823
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
When U0121/94, U0123/62, U0124/95 or U0126/63 are output together with C1231/31, inspect and
repair the trouble areas indicated by U0121/94, U0123/62, U0124/95 or U0126/63 first.
When the speed sensor or the yaw rate sensor has trouble, DTCs for the steering angle sensor may
be output even when the steering angle sensor is normal. When DTCs for the speed sensor or yaw
rate sensor are output together with other DTCs for the steering angle sensor, inspect and repair the
speed sensor and yaw rate sensor first, and then inspect and repair the steering angle sensor.
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the hand-held tester and start from step 2 when not using
the hand-held tester.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER(STEERING ANGLE SENSOR)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Select the DATA LIST mode on the hand-held tester.
Check that the steering angle value of the steering angle sensor indicated on the hand-held tester,
changes when the steering wheel is turned.
Measurement Item /
Range (Display)
Steering sensor/
Min.: -1152 deg, Max.: 1150.875 deg
Item
STEERING ANG
Normal Condition
Min.: -128 deg/s
Max.: 128 deg/s
OK:
Steering angle value should change.
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY
(SEE PAGE 32-37 )
NG
2
CHECK TERMINAL VOLTAGE(STEERING ANGLE SENSOR CONNECTOR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Steering Angle Sensor
(harness side connector)
(+)
(-)
BAT
S14
Remove the steering wheel and the column lower cover.
Disconnect the steering angle sensor connector S14.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S14-1 (IG1) - S14-2 (ESS)
10 to 14 V
S14-3 (BAT) - S14-2 (ESS)
10 to 14 V
IG1
(+)
(-)
ESS
G26292
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
Author:
Date:
1013
05-824
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CDB-18
DTC
C1232/32 MALFUNCTION IN DECELERATION SENSOR
DTC
C1234/34 MALFUNCTION IN YAW RATE SENSOR
DTC
C1243/43 MALFUNCTION IN DECELERATION SENSOR
DTC
C1244/44 OPEN OR SHORT IN DECELERATION
SENSOR CIRCUIT
DTC
C1245/45 MALFUNCTION IN DECELERATION SENSOR
DTC
C1381/97 MALFUNCTION IN POWER SUPPLY
VOLTAGE YAW/DECELERATION SENSOR
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The yaw rate sensor and deceleration sensor signals are sent to the skid control ECU through the CAN communication system. When there is a malfunction in the communication, it will be detected by the diagnosis
function.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
C1232/32
While the vehicle is at a speed of 6mph (10 km/h) or more,
the condition that the fluctuation range of the signal from
either GL1 or GL2 is under 80 mV and the other is above
1.9 V continues for 30 seconds or more.
Yaw rate/deceleration sensor
Yaw rate/deceleration sensor circuit
C1234/34
S
Sensor
malfunction
lf
ti signal
i
l iis reccives
i
ffrom yaw rate
t sensor.
Yaw rate/deceleration sensor
Yaw rate/deceleration sensor circuit
C1243/43
The following condition repeats 16 times.
GL1 and GL2 do not change by more than 2LSB when the
vehicle decelerates from 19 mph (30 km/h) to 0 mph (0
km/h).
Yaw rate/deceleration sensor
Yaw rate/deceleration sensor circuit
C1244/44
When any of the following (1 to 2) is detected:
(1) All the following conditions continues for at least 60 seconds.
Vehicle is stopped.
Difference between IGL1I and IGL2I does not drop below
0.4 G once it reaches 0.6 G or more.
(2) Data malfunction signal is received from G sensor.
Yaw rate/deceleration sensor
Yaw rate/deceleration sensor circuit
C1245/45
The following condition continue for at least 60 seconds.
Difference between the values calculated from G sensor
value and vehicle speed exceeds 0.35 G.
Yaw rate/deceleration sensor
Yaw rate/deceleration sensor circuit
C1381/97
G sensor power source malfunction signal is received for
at least 10 sec. at a speed of more than 2 mph (3 km/h).
Yaw rate/deceleration sensor
Yaw rate/deceleration sensor circuit
Author:
Date:
1014
05-825
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor
CANL
CANH
GND
IG
W
2
B
3
J16
J/C
13
IO2
W
12
IO2
G
20
W
13
IC4
W
L
12
IC4
B
19
9
8
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
25
S27 CANL
11
S27 CANH
W-B
1
Passenger Side J/B
3
IO2
O
5
V
I15
Ignition SW
2 AM1
FL MAIN
4
4J
2
4C
Instrument Panel J/B
G
7
1C
ECU-IG
10
1D
W
6
1C
AM1
1
1A
IG1 4
F7
FL Block
2
1
W
1
Y
ALT
B
A
J19
J/C
W-B A
BF
2
Battery
F46306
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
When U0121/94, U0123/62, U0124/95 or U0126/63 are output together with C1232/32 or C1334/34, inspect
and repair the trouble areas indicated by U0121/94, U0123/62, U0124/95 or U0126/63 first.
1
(a)
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION(YAW RATE SENSOR)
Check that the yaw rate and deceleration sensor has been installed properly (see page 32-46 ).
NG
INSTALL YAW RATE SENSOR CORRECTLY
(SEE PAGE 32-46 )
OK
Author:
Date:
1015
05-826
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(IG TERMINAL)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Yaw Rate Sensor
(harness side connector) Y1
IG
Disconnect the yaw rate sensor connector.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
NG
F45082
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Y1-5 (IG) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(GND TERMINAL)
(a)
(b)
Yaw Rate Sensor
(harness side connector) Y1
Disconnect the yaw rate sensor connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Y1-1 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
GND
F45082
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1016
05-827
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CDC-20
C1241/41 LOW BATTERY POSITIVE VOLTAGE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
C1241/41
When any of the following (1 to 2) is detected:
(1) Any of the following conditions continues for at least 10
seconds.
Vehicle speed is more than 2 mph (3 km/h).
IG1 terminal voltage is less than 9.5 V.
(2) Any of the following conditions continues for at least 0.2
seconds.
Solenoid relay remains ON.
IG1 terminal voltage is less than 9.5 V.
Relay contact is open.
Trouble Area
Battery
Charging system
Power source circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
I15
Ignition SW
Instrument Panel J/B
G
2
AM1 IG1
4
W
7
1C
ECU-IG
10
1D
6
1C
AM1
1
1A
2
Passenger Side J/B
Y
4
4J
2
4H
GR
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
46
10
B-R
IC4
S27 IG1
1
B
W
1
ALT
2
F7
FL Block
FL MAIN
Battery
W-B
32
S27 GND1
A
J4
J/C
W-B
EB
EA
F46315
Author:
Date:
1017
05-828
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE(ECU-IG FUSE)
(a)
(b)
Instrument Panel J/B
ECU-IG
Remove ECU-IG fuse from the instrument panel J/B.
Check continuity of ECU-IG fuse.
Standard:
ECU-IG Fuse
Below 1 Ω (Continuity)
NG
INSPECT FOR SHORT CIRCUIT IN ALL
HARNESS AND COMPONENTS CONNECTED
TO ECU-IG FUSE
NG
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM (SEE PAGE
19-12 (2AZ-FE) OR 19-36 (3MZ-FE))
F40457
OK
2
(a)
INSPECT BATTERY
Check the battery voltage.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery terminal
((+) - (-))
11 to 14 V
OK
Author:
Date:
1018
05-829
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU TERMINAL VOLTAGE(IG1 TERMINAL)
WHEN USING HAND-HELD TESTER:
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Start the engine.
(c) Select the DATA LIST mode on the hand-held tester.
(d) Read the voltage condition output from the ECU displayed on the hand-held tester.
Item
IG VOLTAGE
Measurement Item /
Range (Display)
ECU power supply voltage /
TOO LOW / NORMAL
Normal Condition
NORMAL: 9.5 V or over
TOO LOW: Below 9.5 V
OK:
”Normal” is displayed.
WHEN NOT USING HAND-HELD TESTER:
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector S27.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
GND1
IG1
G24767
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-46 (IG1) - S27-32 (GND1)
10 to 14 V
NG
Go to step 4
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
4
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR(GND TERMINAL CONTINUITY)
(a)
(b)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector S27.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-32 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
GND1
G24767
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (GND TERMINAL - BODY
GROUND)
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (IG1 TERMINAL - BATTERY)
Author:
Date:
1019
05-830
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05H3Q-02
C1246/46 MALFUNCTION IN MASTER CYLINDER
PRESSURE SENSOR
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Master cylinder pressure sensor is connected to the skid control ECU in the actuator.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
C1246/46
When any of the following (1 to 5) is detected:
(1) All the following conditions continues for at least 30 seconds.
Vehicle speed is more than 4 mph (7 km/h).
PMC terminal voltage does not change by more than
0.005 V once it exceeds 0.86 V.
(2) PMC terminal receives interference at least 7 times
within 5 sec.
(3) All the following conditions continues for at least 1.2
seconds.
Stop switch is OFF.
PMC terminal voltage is more than 0.86 V or less than 0.3
V.
(4) All the following conditions continues for at least 1.2
seconds.
IG1 terminal voltage is between 9.5 and 17.2 V.
VCM terminal voltage is not within 4.4 and 5.6 V.
(5) All the following conditions continues for at least 1.2
seconds.
VCM terminal voltage is between 4.4 and 5.6 V.
PMC terminal voltage is not within 0.14 and 4.85 V.
Master cylinder pressure sensor
Master cylinder pressure sensor circuit
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the hand-held tester and start from step 2 when not using the
hand-held tester.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER(MASTER CYLINDER PRESSURE
SENSOR)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Select the DATA LIST mode on the hand-held tester.
Item
MAS CYL PRS 1
(d)
Measurement Item /
Range (Display)
Master cylinder pressure sensor 1
reading / min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
Normal Condition
When brake pedal is released : 0.3 to
0.9 V
Check that the brake fluid pressure value of the master cylinder pressure sensor indicated on the
hand-held tester, changes when the brake pedal is depressed.
Standard:
Brake fluid pressure value should change.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1020
05-831
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU TERMINAL VOLTAGE(STP TERMINAL)
(a)
(b)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
STP
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Switch condition
Specified Condition
S27-27 (STP) Body ground
Brake pedal depressed
8 to 14 V
S27-27 (STP) Body ground
Brake pedal released
Below 1 V
G24767
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH
CIRCUIT
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1021
05-832
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CDD-20
C1249/49 OPEN CIRCUIT IN STOP LIGHT SWITCH
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit recognizes brake operation by sending a stop lamp signal to the skid control ECU.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
C1249/49
All the following conditions continues for at least 0.3 seconds.
IG1 terminal voltage is between 9.5 and 17.2 V.
Open in stop switch circuit.
When the brake pedal load sensing switch is on, the master cylinder pressure is 2MPa or more and the deceleration calculated from the vehicle speed is 0.2 G or more,
the stop lamp switch is off for 2 seconds or more.
Stop lamp bulb
Stop lamp switch
Stop lamp switch circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Passenger Side J/B
S15
Stop Light SW
Y
3
4L
B
1
2
6
IA2
L
11
4A
1
4L
G
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
27
22
G-Y
IC4
S27 STP
B
R7
Stop Light LH
(Rear Comb. Light LH)
B
L
B
B
B J10
J/C
W-B
5
R8
Stop Light RH
(Rear Comb. Light RH)
L
6
J12
J/C
W-B
5
B
B
6
H11
High Mounted Stop Light
5
BG2
L
B
W-B
1
Instrument Panel J/B
1
1E
STOP
FL MAIN
1
1A
B
2
F7
FL Block
B
2
ALT
1
W-B
W
A
J14
J/C
BE
Battery
BC
F46299
Author:
Date:
1022
05-833
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH OPERATION
Check that the stop light comes on when the brake pedal is depressed and goes off when the brake
pedal is released.
HINT:
Check the stop lamp bulb as it may have burnt out.
Standard: Stop lamp switch function is normal.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU TERMINAL VOLTAGE(STP TERMINAL)
(a)
(b)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
STP
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Switch condition
Specified Condition
S27-27 (STP) Body ground
Brake pedal depressed
8 to 14 V
S27-27 (STP) Body ground
Brake pedal released
Below 1 V
G24767
NG
Go to step 5
OK
3
(a)
(b)
(c)
RECONFIRM DTC
Clear the DTCs(see page 05-765 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Are the same DTCs detected? (see page 05-765 ).
NO
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-786 )
YES
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1023
05-834
DIAGNOSTICS
4
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
Stop Lamp Switch Assy
2
1
(a)
(b)
⇔
Free
-
Disconnect the stop lamp switch assy connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Switch condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Switch pin free
1-2
Below 1 Ω
Switch pin pushed in
1-2
10 kΩ or higher
Pushed In
NG
REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
F47536
OK
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(STOP LAMP SWITCH - SKID CONTROL
ECU)
(a)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
(b)
Disconnect the stop lamp switch connector and skid control ECU connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-27 (STP) - S15-1 (STP)
Below 1 Ω
STP
Stop Lamp Switch
(harness side connector)
S15
STP
G25017
C82562
G26188
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY(SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1024
05-835
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05F1S-09
C1251/51 PUMP MOTOR IS LOCKED/OPEN CIRCUIT
IN PUMP MOTOR GROUND
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ABS pump motor is located inside the brake actuator. The motor is used for BA, TRAC and VSC operation.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
C1251/51
Actuator pump motor does not operate properly.
Open in actuator pump motor circuit continues for at least
2 sec.
ABS & TRAC actuator
ABS & TRAC actuator circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
B-O
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
45
S27 R+
ABS R/B
ABS MTR Relay
B-O
B
5
5
1
2
5
3
LG
5
W-L
5
15
S27 MR
2
S27 BM
ABS CUT Relay
5
5
FL MAIN
5
3
1
B-R
5
G-R
5
2
14
S27 MRF
F7
FL Block
W
1
ABS2
9
Battery
F46308
Author:
Date:
1025
05-836
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 in case of using the hand-held tester and start from step 2 in case of not
using the hand-held tester.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY HAND-HELD TESTER(ABS MOTOR RELAY
OPERATION)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the hand-held tester.
Check the operation sound of the ABS motor individually when operating it with the hand-held tester.
Item
ABS MOT RELAY
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
ABS motor relay / ON or OFF
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
ON: Motor relay ON
OK:
The operation sound of the ABS motor should be heard.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
2
INSPECT HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(GND2 OF SKID CONTROL ECU AND
BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-1 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
GND2
G24767
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1026
05-837
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05H3S-03
C1267/67 Brake Pedal Load Sensing Switch
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
C1267/67
Open or short circuit in brake pedal load sensing switch
continues for 0.3 secs. or more.
Immediately after IG1 is turned to the ON position, the
condition that brake pedal load sensing switch is ON and
stop lamp switch is off continues for 10 secs. or more.
While vehicle speed changes from 0 mph (0 km/h0 mph)
to 19 mph (30 km/h19 mph), the condition that the brake
pedal load sensing switch is on repeatedly occurs 5 times.
Trouble Area
Brake pedal load sensing switch
Brake pedal load sensing switch circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
B13
Brake Pedal Load
Sensing SW
Passenger Side J/B
W-B
1
4N
7
4J
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
W-B
P
1
2
6
IC4
G-W
7
S27 FSW+
IC
F46316
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Select the DATA LIST mode on the hand-held tester.
Read the value of the brake pedal load sensing switch displayed on the hand-held tester when depressing and releasing the brake pedal.
Item
BRAKE WRN LIGHT
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Brake load sensing switch / ON or OFF
Diagnostic Note
ON : Depressed brake
pedal
OFF : Released brake
pedal
OK:
Condition
Display
Depress the brake pedal
ON
Release the brake pedal
OFF
OK
Go to step 4
NG
Author:
Date:
1027
05-838
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT BRAKE PEDAL LOAD SENSING SWITCH
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the brake pedal sub-assy.
HINT:
Replace the brake pedal sub-assy when there is a malfunction in the brake pedal load sensing switch.
(a) Disconnect the brake pedal load sensing switch connecB13
FSW+
tor B13.
(b)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
GND
2 1
Brake Pedal Load
table below.
Sensing Switch
Standard:
Release Brake Pedal (ON)
1000 Ω
2
270 Ω
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B13-2
B13
2 (FSW+) B13-1 (GND)
Depress brake pedal
Approx. 1000 Ω
Release brake pedal
Approx. 213 Ω
1
Depress Brake Pedal (OFF)
Brake pedal sub-assy
NG
G26239
REPLACE BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSY
(SEE PAGE 32-1 1)
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(BRAKE PEDAL LOAD SENSING SWITCH SKID CONTROL ECU)
(a)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
FSW+
(b)
Brake Pedal Load Sensing Switch
(harness side connector)
(c)
B13
FSW
G26242
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector S27 and the
brake pedal load sensing switch connector B13.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-7 (FSW+) - B13-2 (FSW)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-7 (FSW+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
Author:
Date:
1028
05-839
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU TERMINAL VOLTAGE(STP TERMINAL)
(a)
(b)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
STP
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Switch condition
Specified Condition
S27-27 (STP) Body ground
Brake pedal depressed
8 to 14 V
S27-27 (STP) Body ground
Brake pedal released
Below 1 V
G24767
NG
INSPECT STOP LAMP SWITCH CIRCUIT
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1029
05-763
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CCX-06
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
ABS & EBD & BA Check Sheet
Inspector’s
:
Name
VIN
Production Date
Customer’s Name
/
/
Licence Plate No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Frequency Problem Occurs
km
miles
Odometer Reading
/
/
Continuously
/
Intermittently (
times a day)
ABS does not operate.
ABS does not operate efficiently.
BA does not operate.
Symptoms
EBD does not operate.
ABS Warning Light
Abnormal
Brake Warning
Light Abnormal
(PKB released)
Remains ON
Does not Come On
Remains ON
Does not Come On
1st Time
Normal System Code
Trouble Code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal System Code
Trouble Code (Code
)
DTC Check
STOP LIGHT SW
OFF
ON
NO SYS
Freeze Frame Data
ABS
SYSTEM
BA
FAIL SF
#IG ON
km/h
MPH
VEHICLE SPD
Author:
Date:
953
05-764
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
TRAC & VSC Check Sheet
Inspector’s
:
Name
VIN
/
Production Date
Customer’s Name
/
Licence No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
/
km
miles
Odometer Reading
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Frequency Problem Occurs
/
Continuous
Intermittent (
times a day)
TRAC does not operate. (Wheels spin when starting rapidly.)
VSC does not operate. (Wheels sideslip at the time of sharp turning.)
TRAC OFF Indicator
Light Abnormal
Symptoms
Check Item
Remains ON
Does not Come On
VSC Warning
Indicator Abnormal
Displays
Does not Display
SLIP Indicator
Light Abnormal
Remains ON
Does not Come On
Skid Control
Buzzer Abnormal
Sounds
Does not Sound
ABS Warning Light
Normal
Trouble Code (Code
)
Malfunction
Indicator Light
Normal
Trouble Code (Code
)
1st Time
Normal System Code
Trouble Code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal System Code
Trouble Code (Code
)
DTC Check
VSC/TRC OFF SW
Freeze Frame Data
SYSTEM
SHIFT POSITION
OFF
ON
VSC/TRAC
P,N
2
R
3
D
4
L
FAIL
STEERING ANG
deg
YAW RAT
deg/s
MAS CYL PRESS
V
THROTTLE
deg
MPa/s
MAS PRESS GRADE
G (RIGHT&LEFT)
G
G (BACK&FORTH)
G
Author:
Date:
954
05-779
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CCZ-12
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit indicated by the DTC. For
details of each code, turn to the page for the respective ”DTC No.” in the DTC chart.
When U0121/94, U0123/62, U0124/95 or U0126/63 are output, inspect and repair the trouble areas
indicated by U0121/94, U0123/62, U0124/95 or U0126/63 first.
DTC chart of ABS:
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Right front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Right front and left front speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor rotor
Sensor installation
Left front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Right front and left front speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor rotor
Sensor installation
Right rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Right rear and left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor rotor
Sensor installation
Left rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
Right rear and left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor rotor
Sensor installation
C0226/21
(05-802 )
Open or short circuit in brake actuator solenoid circuit
(SFR circuit)
ABS & TRAC actuator
SFRH or SFRR circuit
C0236/22
(05-802 )
Open or short circuit in brake actuator solenoid circuit
(SFL circuit)
ABS & TRAC actuator
SFLH or SFLR circuit
C0246/23
(05-802 )
Open or short circuit in brake actuator solenoid circuit
(SRR circuit)
ABS & TRAC actuator
SRRH or SRRR circuit
C0256/24
(05-802 )
Open or short circuit in brake actuator solenoid circuit
(SRL circuit)
ABS & TRAC actuator
SRLH or SRLR circuit
Open circuit in ABS MTR relay circuit
ABS No.2 fuse
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR relay circuit
J/B No.2
Short circuit in ABS MTR relay circuit
ABS No.2 fuse
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR relay circuit
J/B No.2
Open circuit in ABS SOL relay circuit
ABS No.1 fuse
ABS SOL relay
ABS SOL relay circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
C0279/12
(05-809 )
Short circuit in ABS SOL relay circuit
ABS No.1 fuse
ABS SOL relay
ABS SOL relay circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
C1225/25
(05-802 )
Open or short circuit in brake actuator solenoid circuit
(SMC circuit)
SMF or SMR circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
C1235/35
(05-788 )
Foreign matter is attached on the tip of the right front sensor
Right front and left front speed sensor
Each speed sensor
Sensor installation
C0200/31*1
(05-788 )
C0205/32*1
(05-788 )
C0210/33*1
(05-795 )
C0215/34*1
(05-795 )
C0273/13*1
(05-804 )
C0274/14
(05-804 )
C0278/11
(05-809 )
Author:
Date:
969
05-780
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
C1236/36
(05-788 )
Foreign matter is attached on the tip of the left front sensor
Right front and left front speed sensor
Each speed sensor
Sensor installation
C1238/38
(05-795 )
Foreign matter is attached on the tip of the right rear sensor
Right rear and left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor
Sensor installation
C1239/39
(05-795 )
Foreign matter is attached on the tip of the left rear sensor
Right rear and left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor
Sensor installation
C1241/41
(05-827 )
Low battery positive voltage
Battery
Charging system
Power source circuit
Malfunction in deceleration sensor (constant output)
Yaw rate sensor (Deceleration sensor)
Yaw rate sensor circuit (Deceleration sensor circuit)
C1244/44
(05-824 )
Malfunction in deceleration sensor
Yaw rate sensor (Deceleration sensor)
Yaw rate sensor circuit (Deceleration sensor circuit)
C1245/45*1
(05-824 )
Malfunction in deceleration sensor
Yaw rate sensor (Deceleration sensor)
Yaw rate sensor circuit (Deceleration sensor circuit)
C1246/46*2
(05-830 )
Malfunction in master cylinder pressure sensor
Master cylinder pressure sensor
Master cylinder pressure sensor circuit
Open circuit in stop light switch circuit
Stop lamp bulb
Stop lamp switch
Stop lamp switch circuit
ABS pump motor is locked
Open circuit in pump motor circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
ABS & TRAC actuator circuit
Open or short circuit of brake pedal load sensing switch circuit
Brake pedal load sensing switch
Brake pedal load sensing switch circuit
C1361/91
(05-804 )
Short circuit in ABS motor fail safe relay circuit
ABS No.2 fuse
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR relay circuit
J/B No.2
C1381/97
(05-824 )
Malfunction in power supply voltage yaw/deceleration sensor
Yaw rate sensor
Yaw rate sensor power source circuit
U0121/94
(05-2090 )
Malfunction in CAN communication
Wire harness
Skid control ECU
U0124/95
(05-2090 )
Malfunction in CAN communication with deceleration sensor
Wire harness
Yaw rate sensor (Deceleration sensor)
C1243/43*1
(05-824 )
C1249/49
(05-832 )
C1251/51*1
(05-835 )
C1267/67
(05-837 )
*1, *2:
Even after the trouble areas are repaired, the ABS warning light will not go off unless the following operations
are performed.
*1:
(1) Drive the vehicle at 12 mph (20 km/h) for 30 seconds or more and check that the ABS warning
light goes off.
(2) Clear the DTC (see page 05-765 ).
*2:
(1) Keep the vehicle in a stationary condition for 5 seconds or more and depress the brake pedal
lightly 2 or 3 times.
(2) Drive the vehicle at a vehicle speed of 31 mph (50 km/h). Then depress the brake pedal strongly
for about 3 seconds.
(3) Repeat the above operation 3 times or more and check that the ABS warning light goes off.
(4) Clear the DTC (see page 05-765 ).
Author:
Date:
970
05-781
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
HINT:
In some cases, the hand-held tester cannot be used when ABS warning light remains on.
DTC chart of VSC:
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
C1201/51
(05-812 )
Malfunction in ECM
Engine control system
C1203/53
(05-813 )
Malfunction in ECM communication circuit
TRC+ or TRC- circuit
ENG+ or ENG- circuit
ECM
C1210/36
(05-815 )
Zero point calibration of yaw rate sensor undone
Yaw rate sensor (Deceleration sensor)
Zero point calibration undone
C1223/43
(05-817 )
Malfunction in ABS control system
ABS control system
C1224/44
(05-818 )
Open or short circuit in NEO signal circuit
NEO circuit
ECM
Skid control ECU
C1231/31
(05-821 )
Malfunction in steering angle sensor
Steering angle sensor
Steering angle sensor circuit
+B circuit
Can communication system
C1232/32
(05-824 )
Malfunction in deceleration sensor
Yaw rate / deceleration
Yaw rate / deceleration sensor circuit
C1234/34
(05-824 )
Malfunction in yaw rate sensor
Yaw rate / deceleration
Yaw rate / deceleration sensor circuit
C1336/39
(05-815 )
Zero point calibration of deceleration sensor undone
Yaw rate sensor (Deceleration sensor)
Zero point calibration not done
U0123/62
(05-2090 )
Malfunction in CAN communication with yaw rate sensor
Wire harness
Yaw rate sensor (Deceleration sensor)
U0126/63
(05-2090 )
Malfunction in CAN communication with angle position sensor
Wire harness
Steering angle sensor
HINT:
In some cases, the hand-held tester cannot be used when the VSC warning light remains on.
DTC of sensor check function:
Code No.
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
C1271/71
Low output voltage of right front speed sensor
Right front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Sensor rotor
C1272/72
Low output voltage of left front speed sensor
Left front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Sensor rotor
C1273/73
Low output voltage of right rear speed sensor
Right rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Sensor rotor
C1274/74
Low output voltage of left rear speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Sensor rotor
C1275/75
Abnormal change in output voltage of right front speed sensor
Right front sensor rotor
C1276/76
Abnormal change in output voltage of left front speed sensor
Left front speed sensor rotor
C1277/77
Abnormal change in output voltage of right rear speed sensor
Right rear sensor rotor
C1278/78
Abnormal change in output voltage of left rear speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor rotor
Author:
Date:
971
05-782
DIAGNOSTICS
Code No.
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
C1279/79
Deceleration sensor is faulty
Yaw rate sensor (Deceleration sensor)
Sensor installation
C1281/81
Master cylinder pressure sensor output signal is faulty
Master cylinder pressure sensor
C0371/71
Yaw rate sensor output signal is faulty
Yaw rate sensor (Deceleration sensor)
Author:
Date:
972
05-761
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CCW-06
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
The hand-held tester can be used at step 3, 6, 9, 12.
1
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
2
Customer Problem Analysis (SEE PAGE 05-763 )
3
Check and Clear DTCs and Freeze Frame Data (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
4
Problem Symptom Confirmation
Symptom does not occurs: Go to step 5
Symptom occurs: Go to step 6
5
Symptom Simulation (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
6
DTC Check (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
There is no output: Go to step 7
There is output: Go to step 8
7
Problem Symptoms Table (SEE PAGE 05-786 )
Check for fluid leakage and Go to step 10
8
DTC Chart (SEE PAGE 05-779 )
9
Circuit Inspection (SEE PAGE 05-788 to 05-873 )
10
Identification of Problem
Author:
Date:
951
05-762
DIAGNOSTICS
11
Repair
12
Confirmation Test
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
End
Author:
Date:
952
05-783
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CD0-06
LOCATION
VSC R/B
ABS MTR Relay
ABS CNT Relay
Parking Brake Switch
Rear Speed Sensor Rotor
ABS & TRACTION Actuator
(with Skid Control ECU)
Rear Speed Sensor
2WD:
Stop Lamp Switch
Engine Room J/B
ABS NO.1 Fuse
ABS NO.2 Fuse
Front Speed Sensor
Front Speed Sensor Rotor
Rear Speed Sensor and Rotor
Steering Angle Sensor
Combination Meter Assy
ABS Warning Lamp
Brake Warning Lamp
VSC Warning Lamp
TRAC OFF Indicator
Slip Indicator
ECM
Skid Control Buzzer
DLC 3
Driver Side J/B
ECU-IG Fuse
2WD:
TRAC OFF Switch
Yaw Rate Sensor
(Deceleration Sensor)
F46284
Author:
Date:
973
05-765
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05H3Y-02
ABS Warning Light BRAKE Warning
Light
USA:
USA:
Canada:
Canada:
VSC Warning Light SLIP Indicator Light
TRAC OFF Indicator Light
F45096
PRE-CHECK
1.
(a)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Check the warning lights.
(1) Release parking brake lever.
NOTICE:
When releasing the parking brake, set the chocks to hold
the vehicle for safety.
HINT:
When the parking brake is applied or the level of the brake fluid
is low, the BRAKE warning light comes on.
(2) When the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, check that the ABS warning light, BRAKE
warning light, VSC warning light, TRAC OFF indicator light and SLIP indicator light remain on for
approx. 3 seconds.
HINT:
If the ECU has any stored DTCs, the ABS warning light,
VSC warning light and TRAC OFF indicator light come on.
If the indicator does not come on, inspect if the bulb is
blown out, and also the wire harness between the skid
control ECU and the combination meter.
If the indicator remains on, proceed to troubleshooting for
the light circuit below.
Trouble Area
See page
ABS warning light circuit
05-840 or
05-844
VSC warning light circuit
05-847 or
05-851
BRAKE warning light circuit
05-854
TRAC OFF indicator light circuit
05-859
SLIP indicator light circuit
05-863
Author:
Date:
955
05-766
DIAGNOSTICS
DLC3
2.
(a)
Tc
CG
C52361
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
DTC CHECK/CLEAR (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
Check DTCs.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Read the DTC from the ABS warning light or VSC
warning light on the combination meter.
HINT:
If 2 or more malfunctions are detected at the same time,
the lowest numbered code will be displayed first.
If no code appears, inspect the diagnostic circuit, ABS
warning light circuit or VSC warning light circuit.
Trouble Area
See page
Tc and CG terminal circuit
2 sec.
ABS warning light circuit
VSC warning light circuit
05-847 or
05-851
Normal Blinking
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
ON
05-868
05-840 or
05-844
As an example, the blinking patterns for a normal system
code and codes 11 and 21 are shown on the left.
(4) Codes are explained in the code table on page
05-779 .
(5) After completing the check, disconnect terminals Tc
and CG of the DLC3, and turn off the display.
OFF
Code 11 and 21
0.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
4 sec.
2.5 sec.
ON
OFF
Code 11
Code 21
R01346
Author:
Date:
956
05-767
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
BR3890
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
Clear DTCs.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Clear the DTCs stored in the ECU by depressing the
brake pedal 8 or more times within 5 sec.
(4) Check that the ABS warning light and VSC warning
light shows normal blinking patterns.
(5) Remove the SST from the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
HINT:
Cancellation cannot be preformed by removing the battery
cable or the ECU-IG fuse.
3.
DTC CHECK/CLEAR (USING HAND-HELD TESTER)
(a) Check DTCs.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Read the DTCs following the prompts on the tester
screen.
HINT:
Refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(b) Clear the DTCs.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Operate the hand-held tester to erase the codes.
HINT:
Refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
4.
DATA LIST
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed on the Hand-held tester, you can read the value and status of the
switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as a first step of troubleshooting is one of the methods to shorten the labor time.
(a) Connect the Hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) From the display on the tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
*: 2WD only
Item
ABS MOT RELAY
SOL RELAY
VSC / TRC OFF SW*
IDLE SW
Measurement Item /
Range (Display)
ABS motor relay / ON or
OFF
Solenoid relay / ON or
OFF
TRAC control switch / ON
or OFF
Main idle switch / ON or
OFF
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ON : Motor relay ON
-
ON : Solenoid relay ON
-
ON : TRAC control switch ON
-
ON : Accelerator pedal released
OFF : Accelerator pedal
depressed
-
Author:
Date:
957
05-768
DIAGNOSTICS
Item
Measurement Item /
Range (Display)
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop lamp switch / ON or
OFF
PKB SW
Parking brake switch / ON
or OFF
STEP FORCE SW
Brake load sensing switch
/ ON or OFF
ABS OPERT FR
ABS operation (FR) / BEFORE or OPERATE
ABS OPERT FL
ABS operation (FL) / BEFORE or OPERATE
ABS OPERT RR
ABS operation (RR) / BEFORE or OPERATE
ABS OPERT RL
ABS operation (RL) / BEFORE or OPERATE
WHEEL SPD FR
WHEEL SPD FL
WHEEL SPD RR
WHEEL SPD RL
DECELERAT SENS
DECELERAT SENS2
IG VOLTAGE
SFRR
SFRH
SFLR
Wheel speed sensor (FR)
reading / min.: 0 km/h (0
MPH, max.: 326 km/h (202
MPH)
Wheel speed sensor (FL)
reading / min.: 0 km/h (0
MPH, max.: 326 km/h (202
MPH)
Wheel speed sensor (RR)
reading / min.: 0 km/h (0
MPH, max.: 326 km/h (202
MPH)
Wheel speed sensor (RL)
reading / min.: 0 km/h (0
MPH, max.: 326 km/h (202
MPH)
Deceleration sensor 1
reading / min.: -1.869 G,
max.: 1.869 G
Deceleration sensor 2
reading / min.: -1.869 G,
max.: 1.869 G
ECU power supply voltage
/ TOO LOW / NORMAL
ABS solenoid (SFRR) / ON
or OFF
ABS solenoid (SFRH) / ON
or OFF
ABS solenoid (SFLR) / ON
or OFF
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ON : Brake pedal depressed
OFF : Brake pedal released
ON : Parking brake applied
OFF : Parking brake released
ON : Depressed brake
pedal
OFF : Released brake
pedal
BEFORE : No ABS operation (FR)
OPERATE : During ABS
operation (FR)
BEFORE : No ABS operation (FL)
OPERATE : During ABS
operation (FL)
BEFORE : No ABS operation (RR)
OPERATE : During ABS
operation (RR)
BEFORE : No ABS operation (RL)
OPERATE : During ABS
operation (RL)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated
on speedometer
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated
on speedometer
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated
on speedometer
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated
on speedometer
Approximately 0 ± 0.13G
at still condition
Reading changes when vehicle is bounced
Approximately 0 ± 0.13G
at still condition
Reading changes when vehicle is bounced
NORMAL: 9.5 V or over
TOO LOW: Below 9.5 V
-
ON : Operate
-
ON : Operate
-
ON : Operate
-
Author:
Date:
958
05-769
DIAGNOSTICS
Item
SFLH
SRRR (SRR)
SRRH (SRH)
SRLR
SRLH
SMF (BA-SOL)
SMR
THROTTLE
ENGINE SPD
VEHICLE SPD
YAW RATE
YAW ZERO VALUE
STEERING ANG
MAS CYL PRS 1
TEST MODE
#CODES
Measurement Item /
Range (Display)
ABS solenoid (SFLH) / ON
or OFF
ABS solenoid (SRRR
(SRR)) / ON or OFF
ABS solenoid (SRRH
(SRH)) / ON or OFF
ABS solenoid (SRLR) / ON
or OFF
ABS solenoid (SRLH) / ON
or OFF
TRAC solenoid (SMF) /
ON or OFF
TRAC solenoid (SMR) /
ON or OFF
Throttle position sensor/
Min.: 0 deg, Max.: 125 deg
Engine Speed/
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 6,000
rpm
Maximum wheel speed
sensor reading / min.: 0
km/h (0 MPH), max.: 326
km/h (202 MPH)
Yaw rate sensor/
Min.: -128 deg/s, Max.:
128 deg/s
Memorized zero value/
Min.: -128 deg/s, Max.:
128 deg/s
Steering sensor/
Min.: -1152 deg,
Max.: 1150.875 deg
Master cylinder pressure
sensor 1 reading / min.: 0
V, max.: 5 V
Test mode / NORMAL or
TEST
Number of DTC recorded /
min.: 0, max.: 255
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ON : Operate
-
ON : Operate
-
ON : Operate
-
ON : Operate
-
ON : Operate
-
ON : Operate
-
ON : Operate
-
Release accelerator pedal:
Approx. 0 deg.
Depress accelerator pedal:
Approx. 90 deg.
-
Actual engine speed
-
Actual vehicle speed
Similar speed as indicated
on speedometer
Min.: -128 deg/s
Max.: 128 deg/s
-
Min.: -128 deg/s
Max.: 128 deg/s
-
Left turn: Increase
Right turn: Decrease
-
When brake pedal is released : 0.3 to 0.9 V
Reading increases when
brake pedal is depressed
NORMAL : Normal mode
TEST : During test mode
-
Min.: 0, max.: 39
-
Author:
Date:
959
05-770
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
5.
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay and actuator, etc. to operate without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one of the methods to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) According to the display on the tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
HINT:
Ignition switch must be turned to the ON position to proceed to the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester.
Item
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
SFRR
Turns ABS solenoid (SFRR) ON / OFF
SFRH
Turns ABS solenoid (SFRH) ON / OFF
SFLR
Turns ABS solenoid (SFLR) ON / OFF
SFLH
Turns ABS solenoid (SFLH) ON / OFF
SRRR
Turns ABS solenoid (SRRR) ON / OFF
SRRH
Turns ABS solenoid (SRRH) ON / OFF
SRLR
Turns ABS solenoid (SRLR) ON / OFF
SRLH
Turns ABS solenoid (SRLH) ON / OFF
SMF (BA-SOL)
Turns TRAC solenoid SMF (BA-SOL) ON / OFF
SMR
Turns TRAC solenoid SMR ON / OFF
SOL RELAY
Turns ABS solenoid relay ON / OFF
ABS MOT RELAY
Turns ABS motor relay ON / OFF
ABS WARN LIGHT
Turns ABS warning light ON / OFF
VSC WARN LIGHT
Turns VSC warning light ON / OFF
VSC / TRAC OFF IND*
Turns VSC / TRAC OFF indicator ON / OFF
SLIP INDI LIGHT
Turns SLIP indicator light ON / OFF
Author:
Diagnostic Note
Operation of solenoid
(clicking sound) can be
heard
Operation of solenoid
(clicking sound) can be
heard
Operation of solenoid
(clicking sound) can be
heard
Operation of solenoid
(clicking sound) can be
heard
Operation of solenoid
(clicking sound) can be
heard
Operation of solenoid
(clicking sound) can be
heard
Operation of solenoid
(clicking sound) can be
heard
Operation of solenoid
(clicking sound) can be
heard
Operation of solenoid
(clicking sound) can be
heard
Operation of solenoid
(clicking sound) can be
heard
Operation of solenoid
(clicking sound) can be
heard
Operation sound of motor
can be heard
Observe combination meter
Observe combination meter
Observe combination meter
Observe combination meter
Date:
960
05-771
DIAGNOSTICS
Item
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
BRAKE WRN LIGHT
Turns BRAKE warning light ON / OFF
VSC / BR WARN BUZ
Turns VSC / BRAKE warning buzzer ON / OFF
Diagnostic Note
Observe combination meter
Buzzer can be heard
*: 2WD only
6.
FREEZE FRAME DATA
HINT:
Whenever a DTC is detected or the ABS operates, the skid control ECU stores the current vehicle (sensor) state as freeze frame data.
The skid control ECU stores the number of times (maximum: 31) the ignition switch has been turned
from off to the On position since the last time ABS was activated. However, if the vehicle was stopped
or at low speed (4.3 mph (7 km/h) or less), or if a DTC is detected, the skid control ECU will not count
the number since then.
Freeze frame data at the time the ABS operates:
The skid control ECU stores and updates data whenever the ABS system operates.
When the ECU stores data at the time a DTC is detected, the data stored when the ABS operated is
erased.
Freeze frame data at the time a DTC is detected:
When the skid control ECU stores data at the time a DTC is detected, no updates will be performed
until the data is cleared.
(a) Connect the Hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) From the display on the tester, select the ”FREEZE FRAME DATA”.
Hand-held tester display
VEHICLE SPD
Measurement Item
Reference Value
Wheel speed sensor reading
Speed indicated on speedometer
Stop lamp switch signal
Stop lamp switch ON: ON, OFF: OFF
Number of operations of ignition switch ON after
memorizing freeze frame data
0 to 31
MAS CYL PRESS
Master cylinder pressure sensor reading
Brake pedal release : 0.3 to 0.9 V
Brake pedal depress: 0.8 to 4.5 V
MASS PRESS GRADE
Master cylinder pressure sensor change
-30 to 200 MPa/s
System status
ABS activated: ABS
VSC/TRC activated: VSC/TRC
BA activated: BA
Fail safe mode activated: FAIL SF
No system activated: NO SYS
Yaw rate angle sensor reading
-100 to 100
Steering sensor reading
Left turn: Increase
Right turn: Decrease
STOP LIGHT SW
# IG ON
SYSTEM
YAW RATE
STEERING ANG
G (RIGHT & LEFT)
Right and left G
-1.869 to 1.869
G (BACK & FORTH)
Back and forth G
-1.869 to 1.869
VSC (TRC) OFF SW*
TRAC control switch signal
TRC control switch ON: ON
OFF: OFF
Shift lever position
FAIL
P,N
R
D
4
3
2
L
Throttle sensor reading
0 to 125 deg.
SHIFT POSITION
THROTTLE
*: 2WD only
Author:
Date:
961
05-772
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
7.
DLC3
Ts
CG
C52361
SENSOR SIGNAL CHECK (TEST MODE)
(USING SST CHECK WIRE)
NOTICE:
After replacing the yaw rate sensor (deceleration sensor)
and/or brake actuator assembly (skid control ECU), perform zero point calibration of the yaw rate sensor and deceleration sensor. (See step 9.)
HINT:
If the ignition switch is turned from ON to the ACC or
LOCK position during test mode, DTC of sensor check
function will be erased.
During test mode, ECU records all DTCs of sensor check
functions. By preforming sensor signal check, the codes
are erased if normality is confirmed. The codes left over
are the codes where an abnormality was found.
(a) Procedures for test mode:
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Check that the steering wheel is in the straightahead position and shift the shift lever to the P position.
(3) Using SST, connect terminals Ts and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(4) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(5)
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
Check that the ABS warning light and VSC warning
light blink.
HINT:
If the ABS warning light and VSC warning light do not blink, inspect the ABS warning light circuit, VSC warning light and Ts
terminal circuit.
ON
Trouble area
OFF
See Page
Ts and CG terminal circuit
BR3904
05-873
ABS warning light circuit
05-840 or
05-844
VSC warning light circuit
05-847 or
05-851
(b)
Check the master cylinder pressure sensor:
(1) Leave the vehicle in a stationary condition and the
brake pedal in a free condition for 1 second or more,
and quickly depress the brake pedal with a force of
98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf) or more for 1 second or more.
HINT:
At this time, the ABS warning light remains on for 3 seconds.
While the ABS warning light remains on, continue to depress the brake pedal with a force of 98 N (10 kgf) or more.
The ABS warning light comes on for 3 seconds every time
the brake pedal operation above is performed.
Author:
Date:
962
05-773
DIAGNOSTICS
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
If master cylinder pressure sensor check can not be completed, do not depress the brake pedal frequently. It may
further reduce negative pressure and make the sensor
check difficult to complete.
If the negative pressure is insufficient, master cylinder
pressure sensor check may not be completed. In this
case, idle the engine to get enough negative pressure.
If the brake pedal is depressed while engine is stopped,
negative pressure may become insufficient and the BRL
may come on. (It runs the motor and performs incorrect
control.)
(c)
Start Position
Within ± 5°
End Position
-
F02135
Check the yaw rate sensor:
(1) Shift the shift lever to the D position and drive the
vehicle at a speed of approx. 3 mph (5 km/h), turn
the steering wheel either to the left or right 90° or
more, and maintain a 180° circular drive for the vehicle.
(2) Stop the vehicle and shift the shift lever to the P
position, and check that the skid control buzzer
sounds for 3 sec.
NOTICE:
Deceleration sensor check should be completed before
performing speed sensor check.
HINT:
If the skid control buzzer sounds, the sensor check is
completed normally.
If the skid control buzzer does not sound, check the skid
control buzzer circuit (See page 05-866 ), then perform
the sensor check again. If the skid control buzzer still does
not sound, there is a malfunction in the VSC sensor, so
check for DTCs.
Drive the vehicle in a 180° circle. At the end of the turn,
ensure that the vehicle is exactly 180° within a tolerance
of ± 5°, and facing the other direction from its original
start position.
Do not spin the wheels.
(d) Check the speed sensor signal:
(1) Drive the vehicle straight forward at speed of 28
mph (45 km/h) or higher for several seconds and
check that the ABS warning light goes off.
HINT:
The sensor check may not be completed if the vehicle has its
wheels spun or its steering wheel turned during this check.
(2) Stop the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Before performing speed sensor check, complete
master cylinder pressure sensor and deceleration
sensor checks.
Author:
Date:
963
05-774
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
Speed sensor check may not be completed if speed
sensor check is started while turning the steering
wheel or spinning the wheels.
After the ABS warning light goes off, if the vehicle
speed exceeds 50 mph (80 km/h), sensor check code
is stored again. Decelerate or stop the vehicle before
the speed reaches 50 mph (80 km/h).
If sensor check has not been completed, the ABS
warning light blinks while driving and ABS system
does not operate.
HINT:
When sensor check has been completed, the ABS warning light
goes off while driving and blinks in the test mode pattern while
standing.
DLC3
(3)
Using SST, connect terminals Tc and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
Tc
(4)
CG
C52361
Read the number of blinks of the ABS warning light
and VSC warning light.
HINT:
See the list of DTC. (See page 05-779 )
If the check result is OK, the ABS warning light link goes
off when the brake pedal is once depressed.
If every sensor is normal, the normal blinking patterns are
output. (A cycle of 0.25 seconds ON and 0.25 seconds
OFF is repeated.)
If 2 or more malfunctions are detected at the same time,
the lowest numbered code will be displayed first.
Malfunction Code (Example Code 71, 72)
71
0.5 sec.
72
2.5 sec.
ON
OFF
4 sec.
Repeat
0.5 sec. 1.5 sec.
(5)
After performing the check, disconnect the SST
from terminals Ts and CG, Tc and CG of the DLC3
and turn the ignition switch to the off position.
Author:
Date:
964
05-775
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
8.
SENSOR SIGNAL CHECK (TEST MODE)
(USING HAND-HELD TESTER)
NOTICE:
After replacing the yaw rate sensor (deceleration sensor)
and/or brake actuator assembly (skid control ECU), perform zero point calibration of the yaw rate sensor and deceleration sensor. (See step 10.)
HINT:
If the ignition switch is turned from ON to the ACC or
LOCK position during test mode, DTC of sensor check
function will be erased.
During test mode, ECU records all DTC of sensor check
function. By preforming sensor signal check, the codes
are erased if normality is confirmed. The codes left over
are the codes where an abnormality was found.
(a) Procedures for signal check:
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Check that the shift lever position is in the P position.
(3) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(4) Perform the signal check (test mode) by following
the prompts on the tester screen.
[System Selection Screen]
”DIAGNOSIS” - ”OBD/MOBD” - Select the vehicle ”ABS/VSC” - ”SIGNAL CHECK”
(5)
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
Check that the ABS warning light and VSC warning
light blink.
HINT:
If the ABS warning light and VSC warning light do not blink, inspect the ABS warning light circuit and VSC warning light circuit.
ON
Trouble area
See Page
OFF
ABS warning light circuit
05-840 or
05-844
VSC warning light circuit
05-847 or
05-851
BR3904
(b)
Check the master cylinder pressure sensor:
(1) Leave the vehicle in a stationary condition and the
brake pedal in a free condition for 1 second or more
and quickly depress the brake pedal with a force of
98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf) or more for 1 second or more.
HINT:
At this time, the ABS warning light remains on for 3 seconds.
Author:
Date:
965
05-776
DIAGNOSTICS
(c)
Start Position
Within ± 5°
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
Check the yaw rate:
(1) Shift the shift lever to the D position and drive the
vehicle at a speed of approx. 3 mph (5 km/h), and
maintain a 180° circular drive for the vehicle.
(2) Stop the vehicle and shift the shift lever to the P
position, and check that the skid control buzzer
sounds for 3 seconds.
HINT:
End Position
F02135
(d)
If the skid control buzzer sounds, the sensor check is
completed normally.
If the skid control buzzer does not sound, check the skid
control buzzer circuit (See page 05-866 ), then perform
the sensor check again. If the skid control buzzer still does
not sound, there is a malfunction in the VSC sensor, so
check for DTC.
Drive the vehicle in a 180° circle. At the end of the turn,
ensure that the vehicle is exactly 180° within a tolerance
of ± 5°, and facing the other direction from its original
start position.
Do not spin the wheels.
Check the speed sensor:
(1) Drive the vehicle straight forward at the speed of 28
mph (45 km/h) or higher for several seconds and
check that the ABS warning light goes off.
HINT:
The sensor check may not be completed if the vehicle has its
wheels spun or its steering wheel turned during this check.
(2) Stop the vehicle.
(e) Read the DTC following the tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
If the check result is OK, the ABS warning light link goes
off when the brake pedal is once depressed.
9.
IF NECESSARY, PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF YAW RATE SENSOR AND/OR BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
NOTICE:
While obtaining the zero point, do not tilt, move or
shake the vehicle but keep it in a stationary condition.
(Do not start the engine.)
Be sure to perform the operation on a level surface
(within an inclination of 1 %).
(a) Check that the steering wheel is in the straight-ahead
position and shift the shift lever to the P position.
(b) Clear the zero point calibration:
HINT:
When replacing the yaw rate sensor only (not replace the brake
actuator assy).
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Author:
Date:
966
05-777
DIAGNOSTICS
DLC3
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
(2)
Ts
(c)
CG
C52361
Using SST, connect and disconnect terminals Ts
and CG of the DLC3 4 times or more within 8 seconds.
SST 09843-18040
(3) Remove the SST from the terminals of the DLC3.
Obtain the zero point calibration:
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Ts and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(3) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(4) Keep the vehicle in a stationary condition on a level
surface for 2 seconds or more.
(5) Check that the VSC warning light blinks.
HINT:
If the VSC warning light does not blink, perform the zero point
calibration again.
(d) Remove the SST from the terminals of the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(e) Turn the ignition switch off.
10. IF NECESSARY, PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF YAW RATE SENSOR AND/OR
BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY (USING HAND-HELD TESTER)
NOTICE:
While obtaining the zero point, do not tilt, move or shake the vehicle but keep it in a stationary
condition. (Do not start the engine.)
Be sure to perform the operation on a level surface (within an inclination of 1 %).
(a) Check that the steering wheel is in the straight-ahead position and shift the shift lever to the P position.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Perform the reset memory by following the prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
When replace the yaw rate sensor only (not replace the brake actuator assy).
[System Selection Screen]
”DIAGNOSIS” - ”OBD/MOBD” - Select the vehicle - ”ABS/VSC” - ”RESET MEMORY”
F46259
(e)
(f)
Perform the signal check (test mode) by following the prompts on the tester screen.
[System Selection Screen]
”DIAGNOSIS” - ”OBD/MOBD” - Select the vehicle - ”ABS/VSC” - ”SIGNAL CHECK”
Obtain zero point of the yaw rate sensor and deceleration sensor:
(1) Keep the vehicle in a stationary condition on a level surface for 2 seconds or more.
(2) Check that the VSC warning light blinks.
Author:
Date:
967
05-778
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
HINT:
If the VSC warning light does not blink, perform the zero point calibration again.
(g) Turn the ignition switch off.
Author:
Date:
968
05-786
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CD2-13
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
If there are no DTCs output but the problem still occurs, check the circuits for each problem symptom in the
order given in the table below and proceed to the relevant troubleshooting page.
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, sensor, etc., turn the ignition switch off.
Symptoms
Suspected Areas
See page
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal
code is output.
2. IG power source circuit and ground circuit.
3. Speed sensor circuit
ABS does not operate
BA does not operate
EBD does not operate
4. Check the ABS & TRAC actuator with a hand-held tester.
If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage.
5. If the symptoms still occur even after the above circuits
in suspected areas are inspected and proved to be
normal, replace the skid control ECU.
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal
code is output.
2. Speed sensor circuit
ABS does not operate efficiently
BA does not operate efficiently
EBD does not operate efficiently
3. Stop lamp switch circuit
4. Check the ABS & TRAC actuator with a hand-held tester.
If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage.
5. If the symptoms still occur even after the above circuits
in suspected areas are inspected and proved to be
normal, replace the skid control ECU.
05-765
05-827
05-788
05-795
32-36
05-765
05-788
05-795
32-36
ABS warning light abnormal Remain ON
1. ABS warning light circuit
2. Skid control ECU
05-840
-
ABS warning light abnormal Does not light up
1. ABS warning light circuit
2. Skid control ECU
05-844
05-765
DTC of ABS check cannot be done
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal
code is output.
2. TC terminal circuit
3. If the symptoms still occur even after the above circuits
in suspected areas are inspected and proved to be
normal, replace the skid control ECU.
Sensor signal check cannot be done
1. TS terminal circuit
2. Skid control ECU
05-873
-
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal
code is output.
2. IG power source circuit and ground circuit.
3. Check the hydraulic circuit for leakage.
4. Speed sensor circuit
05-765
VSC and/or TRAC does not operate
5. Deceleration sensor circuit
6. Yaw rate sensor circuit
7. Steering sensor circuit
8. If the symptoms still occur even after the above circuits
in suspected areas are inspected and proved to be
normal, replace the skid control ECU.
SLIP indicator light abnormal
1. SLIP indicator light circuit
2. Skid control ECU
Author:
05-868
05-827
05-788
05-795
05-815
05-824
05-824
05-821
05-863
-
Date:
976
05-787
DIAGNOSTICS
Symptoms
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
Suspected Areas
See page
05-765
TRAC OFF indicator abnormal
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal
code is output.
2. TRAC control switch circuit
3. If the symptoms still occur even after the above circuits
in suspected areas are inspected and proved to be
normal, replace the skid control ECU.
05-765
DTC of VSC check cannot be done
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal
code is output.
2. TC terminal circuit
3. If the symptoms still occur even after the above circuits
in suspected areas are inspected and proved to be
normal, replace the skid control ECU.
05-765
VSC warning light abnormal Remain ON
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal
code is output.
2. VSC warning circuit
3. If the symptoms still occur even after the above circuits
in suspected areas are inspected and proved to be
normal, replace the skid control ECU.
05-765
VSC warning light abnormal Does not light up
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal
code is output.
2. VSC warning circuit
3. If the symptoms still occur even after the above circuits
in suspected areas are inspected and proved to be
normal, replace the skid control ECU.
Author:
Date:
05-859
05-868
05-847
05-851
977
05-866
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CDL-18
SKID CONTROL BUZZER CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The skid control buzzer sounds and Slip Indicator blinking during VSC operation.
WIRING DIAGRAM
I15
Ignition SW
G
2 AM1 IG1 4
W
Instrument Panel J/B
7
1C
ECU-IG
6
1C
AM1
2
10
1D
1
1A
1
V8
Passenger Side J/B VSC Warning
4
8
20
Buzzer
Y
O
G
4M
IC4
4J
2
1
B
2
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
BR-W
30
S27 BZ
W
ALT
F7
FL Block
1
FL MAIN
Battery
F46317
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the hand-held tester and start from step 2 when not using the
hand-held tester.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY HAND-HELD TESTER(SKID CONTROL BUZZER)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Select the item ”VSC/BR WARN BUZ” in the ACTIVE TEST and operate the skid control buzzer on
the hand-held tester.
Item
VSC / BR WARN BUZ
(d)
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Turns VSC / BRAKE warning buzzer ON / OFF
Diagnostic Note
Buzzer can be heard
Check that skid control buzzer sounds by operating with the hand-held tester.
OK:
The skid control buzzer sounds in accordance with operation of the hand-held tester.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1056
05-867
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL BUZZER ASSY
2
(a)
(b)
1
(+)
(-)
Skid Control Buzzer
F02192
Disconnect the skid control buzzer connector.
Apply a battery positive voltage to terminals 1 and 2 of the
skid control buzzer connector, and check that the buzzer
sounds.
OK:
The skid control buzzer sound should be heard.
NG
REPLACE SKID CONTROL BUZZER ASSY
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL BUZZER - SKID
CONTROL ECU)
(a)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
(b)
BZ
Skid Control Buzzer
(harness side connector) V8
BZ
(c)
IG1
G26280
Disconnect the skid control buzzer connector and the skid
control ECU connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-30 (BZ) - V8-1 (BZ)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-30 (BZ) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1057
05-863
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CDK-07
SLIP INDICATOR LIGHT CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SLIP indicator blinks during TRAC & VSC operation.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
22
S27 TRC8
S27 TRC+
23
S27 ENG9
S27 ENG+
ECM
31
TRC- E5
25
TRC+ E5
30
ENG- E5
24
ENG+ E5
G
19
IC4
Y-B
Y
7
IC4
G-B
R
18
IC4
W-G
V
5
IC4
W-L
Combination Meter
18
E6
29
MPX2 E6
System
I15
Ignition SW
IG1 4
W
7
13
1K
AM1
1
1A
1C
6
1C
P
Slip
HEATER
2
FL MAIN
1
C11
Instrument Panel J/B
G
2 AM1
21
C11
9
C12
MPX
MPX1
Center J/B
4
3A
B
7
3C
B
F7
FL Block
1
W
1
ALT
2
Battery
F46302
Author:
Date:
1053
05-864
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the hand-held tester and start from step 2 when not using the
hand-held tester.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY HAND-HELD TESTER(SLIP INDICATOR LIGHT)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Select the item ”SLIP INDI LIGHT” in the ACTIVE TEST and operate the SLIP indicator light on the
hand-held tester.
Item
SLIP INDI LIGHT
(d)
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Turns SLIP indicator light ON / OFF
Diagnostic Note
Observe combination meter
Check that ”ON” and ”OFF” of the SLIP indicator light are indicated on the combination meter when
using the hand-held tester.
OK:
Turn the SLIP indicator light on or off in accordance with the hand-held tester.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
2
INSPECT MULTIPLEX COMMUNCATION SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 05-2040 )
NG
REPAIR
SYSTEM
MULTIPLEX
COMMUNCATION
OK
Author:
Date:
1054
05-865
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(ECM - SKID CONTROL ECU)
S27
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector)
(a)
ENG+
(b)
TRC+
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector S27 and ECM
connector E5.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-8 (TRC+) - E5-25 (TRC+)
S27-22 (TRC-) - E5-31 (TRC-)
Below 1 Ω
S27-9 (ENG+) - E5-24 (ENG+)
TRC-
ENG-
S27-23 (ENG-) - E5-30 (ENG-)
ECM
(c)
E5
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
ENG+
S27-8 (TRC+) - Body ground
S27-22 (TRC-) - Body ground
TRC+
10 kΩ or higher
S27-9 (ENG+) - Body ground
TRCF44428
F45165
Specified Condition
S27-23 (ENG-) - Body ground
ENGF45351
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
4
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY(SLIP INDICATOR LIGHT)
(SEE PAGE 05-1868 )
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1055
05-868
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05F1X-07
TC AND CG TERMINAL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Connecting terminals TC and CG of the DLC3 causes the ECU to display the DTC by flashing the ABS warning light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
with Actuator
22
S27 TRC8
S27 TRC+
ECM
31
TRC- E5
25
TRC+ E5
30
ENG- E5
24
ENG+ E5
19
IC4
7
IC4
18
IC4
5
IC4
G
Y
R
V
Y-B
G-B
23
S27 ENG9
S27 ENG+
W-G
W-L
J16
J/C
20
TC E5
O
O
D
D
D3
DLC3
TC
13
Passenger Side J/B
CG
W-B
4
6
4C
1
4N
7
4L
W-B
W-B
IC
F46319
Author:
Date:
1058
05-869
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
D3
DLC3
INSPECT DLC3 TERMINAL VOLTAGE(DLC3 TERMINAL VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
TC
CG
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D3-13 (TC) - D3-4 (CG)
10 to 14 V
C52361
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
D3
DLC3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(ECM - DLC3)
(a)
(b)
TC
(c)
ECM
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-20 (TC) - D3-13 (TC)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Wire Harness View
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D3-13 (TC) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E5
TC
NG
I37937
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
Author:
Date:
1059
05-870
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(ECM - SKID CONTROL ECU)
(a)
Skid Control ECU
S27
(harness side connector)
ENG+
(b)
ENG-
(c)
ECM
Wire Harness View
E5
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and the ECM
connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-24 (ENG+) - S27-9 (ENG+)
Below 1 Ω
E5-30 (ENG-) - S27-23 (ENG-)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-9 (ENG+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S27-23 (ENG-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
ENG+
ENGG26436
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
4
D3
DLC3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(DLC 3 - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
TC
CG
C52361
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D3-4 (CG) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
Author:
Date:
1060
05-871
DIAGNOSTICS
5
D3
DLC3
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(ECM - DLC3)
(a)
(b)
TC
(c)
ECM
-
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-20 (TC) - D3-13 (TC)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Wire Harness View
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D3-13 (TC) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E5
TC
I37937
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
Author:
Date:
1061
05-872
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(ECM - SKID CONTROL ECU)
(a)
Skid Control ECU
S27
(harness side connector)
ENG+
(b)
ENG-
(c)
ECM
Wire Harness View
E5
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and the ECM
connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-24 (ENG+) - S27-9 (ENG+)
Below 1 Ω
E5-30 (ENG-) - S27-23 (ENG-)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-9 (ENG+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S27-23 (ENG-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
ENG+
ENGG26436
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1062
05-784
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CD1-12
TERMINALS OF ECU
SKID CONTROL ECU
S27
F45080
Symbols (Terminals No.)
BM (S27-2) - GND (Y1-1)
FR+ (S27-3) - FR- (S27-17)
FSW+ (S27-7) - GND1
(S27-32)
Wiring Color
W-L - W-B
R-Y - LG
G-W - W-B
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
Motor relay test input
IG switch ON, pump motor running
10 to 14 V
Front RH wheel speed
signal input
IG switch ON, slowly turn right front
wheel
AC generation
FSW switch input
IG switch ON, brake pedal released
2 to 4 V
FL+ (S27-18) - FL- (S27-4)
O -P
Front LH wheel speed
signal input
IG switch ON, slowly turn left front
wheel
AC generation
RR+ (S27-5) - RR- (S27-19)
Y - BR
Rear RH wheel speed
signal input
IG switch ON, slowly turn right rear
wheel
AC generation
RL+ (S27-20) - RL- (S27-6)
Y-G - G
Rear LH wheel speed signal input
IG switch ON, slowly turn left rear
wheel
AC generation
TRC+ (S27-8) - TRC(S27-22)
G-B - Y-B
ECM communication output
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
ENG+ (S27-9) - ENG(S27-23)
W-L - W-G
ECM communication input
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
NEO (S27-10) - GND1
(S27-32)
V - W-B
Engine rpm signal input
Engine idling
Pulse generation
CANH (S27-11) - CANL
(S27-25)
B-W
CAN communication line
IG switch OFF
54 to 67 Ω
D/G (S27-13) - GND1
(S27-32)
GR-B - W-B
Diagnosis tester communication line
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
SP1 (S27-12) - GND1
(S27-32)
BR-R - W-B
Speed signal output
Vehicle drives at about
20 km/h (12 mph)
Fail safe motor relay output
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
MRF (S27-14) - R+ (S27-45)
G-R - B-O
Pulse generation
MR (S27-15) - R+ (S27-45)
LG - B-O
Motor relay output
IG switch ON, pump motor running
10 to 14 V
+BS (S27-31) - GND1
(S27-32)
B - W-B
Solenoid relay power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
Sensor check input
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
Stop light switch ON (Brake pedal
pushed)
8 to 14 V
Stop light switch OFF (Brake pedal
released)
Below 1.5 V
TS (S27-24) - GND1 (S27-32)
STP (S27
(S27-27)
27) - GND1
(S27-32)
P-B - W-B
G Y - W-B
G-Y
WB
St light
Stop
li ht switch
it h input
i
t
Author:
Date:
974
05-785
DIAGNOSTICS
PKB (S27
(S27-28)
28) - GND1
(S27-32)
WA (S27-29)
(S27 29) - GND1
(S27-32)
BZ (S27-30) - GND1 (S27-32)
R W - W-B
R-W
WB
R L - W-B
R-L
WB
BR-W - W-B
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
Parking brake switch in
input
ABS warning
i lilight
ht output
t t
Buzzer output
IG switch ON, parking brake switch
ON
Below 1.5 V
IG switch ON, parking brake switch
OFF
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON, ABS warning light
ON
6 to 11 V
IG switch ON, ABS warning light
OFF
Below 2.0 V
IG switch ON, VSC buzzer sounds
Below 1.0 ↔ 10 to 14 V
IG switch ON, VSC buzzer does not
sound
10 to 14 V
VSCW (S27-36) - GND1
(S27-32)
L-Y - W-B
VSC warning light output
IG switch ON, VSC warning light
ON
CSW* (S27-43) - GND1
(S27-32)
L-R - W-B
TRAC OFF switch input
TRAC OFF switch OFF
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON, BRAKE warning light
ON
6 to 11 V
IG switch ON, BRAKE warning light
OFF
Below 2.0 V
BRL (S27
(S27-44)
44) - GND1
(S27-32)
LG B - W-B
LG-B
WB
B k warning
Brake
i lilight
ht output
t t
Below 2.0 V
R+ (S27-45) - GND1 (S27-32)
B-O - W-B
Power supply for motor
relay
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
IG1 (S27-46) - GND1
(S27-32)
B-R - W-B
IG1 power supply
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
*: 2WD only
Author:
Date:
975
05-859
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05H3X-03
TRAC OFF INDICATOR LIGHT, TRAC OFF SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU detects the track control main switch ON/OFF signal and turns the track off light on/off.
This is the TRAC control main switch. When the TRAC control switch is pressed, the TRAC control does not
operate and the TRAC OFF light comes on.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
31
TRC- E5
25
TRC+ E5
30
ENG- E5
24
ENG+ E5
19
IC4
7
IC4
18
IC4
5
IC4
G
Y
R
V
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
22
S27 TRC8
S27 TRC+
23
S27 ENG9
S27 ENG+
Y-B
G-B
W-G
W-L
Combination Meter
18
MPX1 E6
29
MPX2 E6
21
C11
9
C12
MPX
System
I15
Ignition SW
1
C11
TRAC
OFF
Center J/B
Instrument Panel J/B
G
7
1C
HEATER
13
1K
W
6
1C
AM1
1
1A
2 AM1 IG1 4
F7
FL Block
2
1
P
B
4
3A
7
3C
B
W
1
ALT
2
T6
Trac Off SW
1
FL MAIN
W-B
(*1)
13
W
IF3
4 (*1)
Center J/B
4
3J
17
IC4
W
(*1)
13
3F
L-R
(*1)
43
S27 CSW
W-B
Battery
IB
*1 : 2WD
F46300
Author:
Date:
1049
05-860
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the hand-held tester and start from step 2 when not using the
hand-held tester.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY HAND-HELD TESTER(TRAC OFF INDICATOR
LIGHT)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Select the item ”TRAC OFF LIGHT” in the ACTIVE TEST and operate the TRAC OFF indicator light
on the hand-held tester.
Item
VSC / TRAC OFF IND
(d)
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Diagnostic Note
Observe combination meter
Turns VSC / TRAC OFF indicator ON / OFF
Check that ”ON” and ”OFF” of the TRAC OFF indicator light are indicated on the combination meter
when using the hand-held tester.
OK:
Turn the TRAC OFF indicator light on or off in accordance with the hand-held tester.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
2
INSPECT TRACTION CONTROL SWITCH
(a)
(b)
(c)
T6
4
Remove the TRAC control switch.
Disconnect the TRAC control switch connector T6.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
1
T6 4 - T6-1
T6-4
T6 1
F00052
NG
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
Pushed in (ON)
Below 1 Ω
Released (OFF)
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE TRACTION CONTROL SWITCH
OK
Author:
Date:
1050
05-861
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL ECU - TRAC OFF
SWITCH)
(a)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
(b)
TRAC Control Switch
(harness side connector)
E
CSW
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector S27 and the
TRAC control switch connector T6.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-43 (CSW) - T6-4 (+)
Below 1 Ω
S27-43 (CSW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T6-1 (E) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
T6
+
NG
F46260
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
4
INSPECT MULTIPLEX COMMUNCATION SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 05-2040 )
NG
REPAIR
SYSTEM
MULTIPLEX
COMMUNCATION
OK
Author:
Date:
1051
05-862
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL ECU - ECM)
S27
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector)
(a)
ENG+
(b)
TRC+
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector S27 and ECM
connector E5.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-8 (TRC+) - E5-25 (TRC+)
S27-22 (TRC-) - E5-31 (TRC-)
Below 1 Ω
S27-9 (ENG+) - E5-24 (ENG+)
TRC-
ENG-
S27-23 (ENG-) - E5-30 (ENG-)
ECM
(c)
E5
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
ENG+
S27-8 (TRC+) - Body ground
S27-22 (TRC-) - Body ground
TRC+
10 kΩ or higher
S27-9 (ENG+) - Body ground
TRCF44428
F45165
Specified Condition
S27-23 (ENG-) - Body ground
ENGF45351
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
6
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY (SEE PAGE 05-1868 )
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1052
05-873
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05F1Y-08
TS AND CG TERMINAL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
In the sensor check mode, a malfunction of the speed sensor that cannot be detected when the vehicle is
stopped is detected while driving.
Transition to the sensor check mode can be performed by connecting terminals TS and CG of the DLC3 and
turning the ignition switch from off to the ON position.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Passenger Side J/B
W-B
7
4L
1
4N
6
4C
D3 Data Link Connector 3
W-B
4
CG
TS
W
12
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
8
IC4
P-B
24
S27 TS
W-B
IC
F46320
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
DLC3
INSPECT DLC3 TERMINAL VOLTAGE(TS TERMINAL)
(a)
(b)
TS
D3
CG
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D3-12 (TS) - D3-4 (CG)
10 to 14 V
C52361
NG
Go to step 3
OK
Author:
Date:
1063
05-874
DIAGNOSTICS
2
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
(c)
D3
DLC3
-
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-24 (TS) - D3-12 (TS)
Below 1 Ω
TS
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
TS
S27-24 (TS) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
G24767
C52361
I37493
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(BODY GROUND - DLC3)
(a)
DLC3
D3
CG
C52361
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D3-4 (CG) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
Author:
Date:
1064
05-875
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
G24767
C52361
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL ECU - DLC3)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
D3
DLC3
-
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-24 (TS) - D3-12 (TS)
Below 1 Ω
TS
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
TS
S27-24 (TS) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
I37493
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1065
05-847
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05CDH-11
VSC WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT (REMAINS ON)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If the ECU stores DTC, the VSC warning light comes on in the combination meter.
WIRING DIAGRAM
16
IF3
P
5
IC2
V
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
36
L-Y
S27 VSCW
Combination Meter
7
C12
13
C11
9
IL1
SB
VSC
J6
J/C
Passenger Side J/B
4
4M
4
4J
1
4E
2
4H
P
P
E
E
10
IC4
GR
10
1D
ECU-IG
7
1C
W
6
1G
IGN
1
1C
1
1A
AM1
F7
FL Block
W
B
1
ALT
2
1
L-Y
AM2
10
6
1C
46
S27 IG1
I15
Ignition SW
Instrument Panel J/B
Y
B-R
G
4 IG1
AM1 2
GR
6 IG2
AM2 7
W
2
1
IC1
Y
FL MAIN
Battery
F46303
Author:
Date:
1037
05-848
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK DTC
Is DTC output for ABS and VSC?
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
A
2
INSPECT CHECK IF SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR IS SECURELY
CONNECTED
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO ECU
NG
INSPECT CHARGING SYSTEM (SEE PAGE
19-12 (2AZ-FE) OR 19-36 (3MZ-FE))
OK
3
(a)
INSPECT BATTERY
Check the battery voltage.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery terminal
((+) - (-))
11 to 14 V
OK
Author:
Date:
1038
05-849
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU TERMINAL VOLTAGE(IG1 TERMINAL)
WHEN USING HAND-HELD TESTER:
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Start the engine.
(c) Select the DATA LIST mode on the hand-held tester.
(d) Check the voltage condition output from the ECU displayed on the hand-held tester.
Item
IG VOLTAGE
Measurement Item /
Range (Display)
ECU power supply voltage / TOO
LOW / NORMAL
Normal Condition
NORMAL: 9.5 V or over
UNDER: Below 9.5 V
OK:
”Normal” is displayed.
WHEN NOT USING HAND-HELD TESTER:
(a) Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector) S27
GND1
IG1
G24767
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-46 (IG1) - S27-32 (GND1)
11 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
Author:
Date:
1039
05-850
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION
METER)
(a)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector)
(b)
S27
(c)
VSCW
Combination Meter
(harness side view)
C12
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and combination meter connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C12 - 7 - S27-36 (VSCW)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-36 (VSCW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
F46287
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
6
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL ECU - BODY GROUND)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector)
(a)
(b)
S27
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-32 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
GND1
G24767
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1040
05-851
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
05F1U-05
VSC WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT (DOES NOT LIGHT UP)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If the ECU stores DTC, the VSC warning light comes on in the combination meter.
WIRING DIAGRAM
16
IF3
P
5
IC2
V
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
36
L-Y
S27 VSCW
Combination Meter
7
C12
13
C11
9
IL1
SB
VSC
J6
J/C
Passenger Side J/B
4
4M
4
4J
1
4E
2
4H
P
P
E
E
10
IC4
GR
10
1D
ECU-IG
7
1C
W
6
1G
IGN
1
1C
1
1A
AM1
F7
FL Block
W
B
1
ALT
2
1
L-Y
AM2
10
6
1C
46
S27 IG1
I15
Ignition SW
Instrument Panel J/B
Y
B-R
G
4 IG1
AM1 2
GR
6 IG2
AM2 7
W
2
1
IC1
Y
FL MAIN
Battery
F46303
Author:
Date:
1041
05-852
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK VSC WARNING LIGHT
WHEN USING HAND-HELD TESTER:
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 and start the engine.
(b) Select the item ”VSC WARN LIGHT” in the ACTIVE TEST and operate the VSC warning light on the
hand-held tester.
(c) Check that ”ON” and ”OFF” of the VSC warning light are indicated on the combination meter when using the hand-held tester.
Item
VSC WARN LIGHT
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Turns VSC warning light ON / OFF
Diagnostic Note
Observe combination meter
OK:
Turn the VSC warning light ON or OFF in accordance with the hand-held tester.
WHEN NOT USING HAND-HELD TESTER:
Skid Control ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch off and disconnect the connector
(harness side connector) S27
from the skid control ECU.
(b) Ground the terminal VSCW of skid control ECU.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Check that the VSC warning light.
OK:
Turn the light ON or OFF in accordance with the conVSCW
necting condition of terminal VSCW and body
G24767
ground.
NG
CHECK AND REPAIR VSC WARNING LIGHT
CIRCUIT (SEE PAGE 05-1868 )
OK
Author:
Date:
1042
05-853
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ABS WITH EBD & BA & TRAC & VSC SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SKID CONTROL ECU - COMBINATION
METER)
(a)
Skid Control ECU
(harness side connector)
(b)
S27
(c)
VSCW
Combination Meter
(harness side view)
C12
Disconnect the skid control ECU connector and combination meter connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C12 - 7 - S27-36 (VSCW)
Below 1 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S27-36 (VSCW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
F46287
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ABS & TRACTION ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-37 )
Author:
Date:
1043
05-1998
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B2780
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
05A2A-06
PUSH SWITCH/KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC will be output if the transponder key ECU does not detect that the unlock warning switch is ON
even when the ignition switch is ON (under normal condition, the unlock warning switch is ON when the ignition switch is ON).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Unlock warning switch ON is not detected when ignition
switch is ON
B2780
Unlock warning switch assy
Wire harness
Transponder key ECU assy
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transponder Key ECU Assy
K4
Unlock Warning
Switch Assy
W-B
9 4G
7
1
2
J6
Junction Connector
G
D
D
G
10
T14 KSW
Passenger
Side J/B
4L
W-B
IC
B51715
B79970
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2188
05-1999
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the hand-held tester and start from step 2 when not using the
hand-held tester.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU (SWITCH CONDITION))
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON with the key that cannot start the engine.
On the hand-held tester, select the following menu item: DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA
LIST/IMMOBILISER/KEY SW. Read the values.
OK: ”ON” (Key is in ignition key cylinder) appears on the screen.
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
KEY SW
Unlock warning switch signal
/ON or OFF
ON: Key is in ignition key cylinder
OFF: No key is in ignition key cylinder
-
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY
2
INSPECT UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY
(a)
(b)
Not pushed
Pushed
Remove the unlock warning switch.
Measure the resistance of the unlock warning switch.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Switch Position
1-2
Pushed
Below 1 Ω
1-2
Not pushed
10 kΩ or higher
2 1
4 3
B51581
NG
Specified Condition
REPLACE UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2189
05-2000
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY - UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
T14
Transponder Key ECU Assy
Disconnect the T14 ECU and K4 switch connectors.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
T14-10 (KSW) - K4-2
Below 1 Ω
KSW
K4
Unlock Warning Switch Assy
NG
B63404
B65748
B78556
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2190
05-2001
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B2784
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
05A2C-09
ANTENNA COIL OPEN/SHORT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The transponder key coil is built into the transponder key amplifier and receives a key code signal from the
transponder chip in the key. This signal is amplified by the amplifier, then it is output to the transponder key
ECU assy.
DTC No.
B2784
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Wire harness
Transponder key amplifier
Transponder key ECU assy
Antenna coil is open/short
WIRING DIAGRAM
T14
Transponder Key ECU Assy
T7
Transponder Key Amplifier
ANT1
B
8
CODE 4
GR
11
TXCT 5
W
12
GND
R
13
VC5
CODE
Amplifier
Transponder
Key Coil
1
VC5
7
ANT2
TXCT
AGND
B62676
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2191
05-2002
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the hand-held tester and start from step 2 when not using the
hand-held tester.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(IMMOBILIZER ECU (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY) (SWITCH CONDITION))
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON with the key that does not start the engine.
Select the item ”ANTENNA COIL” on the hand-held tester.
OK: ”NORMAL” (Antenna coil is normal) appears on the screen.
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
ANTENNA COIL
Antenna coil condition
/NORMAL or FAIL
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
NORMAL: Antenna coil is normal
FAIL: Antenna coil is abnormal
NG
-
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY - TRANSPONDER KEY
AMPLIFIER) (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY OR
TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
Disconnect the T14 ECU and T7 amplifier connectors.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
T14
Transponder Key ECU Assy
T7
Transponder Key Amplifier
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T14-8 (VC5) - T7-1 (VC5)
Below 1 Ω
T14-11 (CODE) - T7-4 (CODE)
Below 1 Ω
T14-12 (TXCT) - T7-5 (TXCT)
Below 1 Ω
T14-13 (AGND) - T7-7 (GND)
Below 1 Ω
T14-8 (VC5) or T7-1 (VC5) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T14-11 (CODE) or T7-4 (CODE) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T14-12 (TXCT) or T7-5 (TXCT) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T14-13 (AGND) or T7-7 (GND) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
B63404
B55013
B64974
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2192
05-2003
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B2793
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
052IH-1 1
TRANSPONDER CHIP MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when trouble is found in a key during the key code registration or the key code is not
registered normally. Replace the key when the key code registration is not performed normally and this DTC
is detected.
DTC No.
B2793
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Key
Transponder chip malfunction
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK DTC
Delete the DTC.
Insert the key into the ignition key cylinder.
Check that no code is output.
OK
NO PROBLEM
NG
2
(a)
(b)
RE-REGISTER KEY
Delete the DTC.
Re-register the key, and check that the engine starts with the key.
OK
NORMAL
NG
REPLACE KEY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2193
05-2004
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B2794
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
052II-10
UNMATCHED ENCRYPTION CODE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a key with an incomplete key code is inserted into the ignition key cylinder.
DTC No.
B2794
DTC Detection Condition
Key with incomplete key code is inserted
Trouble Area
Key
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
REPLACE KEY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2194
05-2005
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B2795
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
052IJ-12
UNMATCHED KEY CODE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a key with a key code that has not been registered in the ECU is inserted into the
ignition key cylinder.
DTC No.
B2795
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Key
Key with unregistered key code is inserted
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
DELETE DTC AND INSERT ALL PRESENTLY AVAILABLE KEYS TO CHECK
WHETHER ENGINE STARTS OR NOT
OK
NO PROBLEM
(BECAUSE OF KEY RE-REGISTRATION)
NG
REPLACE KEY THAT DOES NOT START ENGINE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2195
05-2006
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
05A2G-10
DTC
B2796
NO COMMUNICATION IN IMMOBILIZER
SYSTEM
DTC
B2798
COMMUNICATION MALFUNCTION NO. 2
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This code is stored in the memory when a key that does not have a transponder chip is inserted or if communication between the key and transponder key ECU assy is impossible.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2796
No communication
Key
Wire harness
Transponder key amplifier
Transponder key ECU assy
B2798
Communication error
Key
WIRING DIAGRAM
T14
Transponder Key ECU Assy
T7
Transponder Key Amplifier
ANT1
B
8
CODE 4
GR
11
TXCT 5
W
12
GND
R
13
VC5
CODE
Amplifier
Transponder
Key Coil
1
VC5
7
ANT2
TXCT
AGND
B62676
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2196
05-2007
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 1 when using the hand-held tester and start from step 2 when not using the
hand-held tester.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(IMMOBILISER ECU (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY) (SWITCH CONDITION))
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON with the key that does not start the engine.
Select the item ”IMMOBILIZER” on the hand-held tester.
OK: ”SET” (Ignition switch ON) appears on the screen.
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
IMMOBILIZER
Immobilizer system status
/SET or UNSET
OK
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
UNSET: Without key
SET: Ignition switch ON
-
NORMAL
NG
2
(a)
CHECK WHETHER ENGINE STARTS WITH OTHER KEYS
Check whether the engine starts with the other keys for the vehicle.
OK
RE-REGISTER OR REPLACE KEY THAT WILL
NOT START ENGINE
NG
HINT:
Start the inspection from step 3 when using the hand-held tester and start from step 4 when not using the
hand-held tester.
3
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(IMMOBILIZER ECU (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY) (SWITCH CONDITION))
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON with the key that does not start the engine.
On the hand-held tester, select the following menu item: DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA
LIST/IMMOBILIZER/ANTENNA COIL. Read the values.
OK: ”NORMAL” (Antenna coil is normal) appears on the screen.
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
ANTENNA COIL
Antenna coil condition
/NORMAL or FAIL
NG
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
NORMAL: Antenna coil is normal
FAIL: Antenna coil is abnormal
-
CHECK AND REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY
ECU ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2197
05-2008
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY - TRANSPONDER KEY
AMPLIFIER) (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY OR TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
Disconnect the T14 ECU and T7 amplifier connectors.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
T14
Transponder Key ECU Assy
T7
Transponder Key Amplifier
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T14-8 (VC5) - T7-1 (VC5)
Below 1 Ω
T14-11 (CODE) - T7-4 (CODE)
Below 1 Ω
T14-12 (TXCT) - T7-5 (TXCT)
Below 1 Ω
T14-13 (AGND) - T7-7 (GND)
Below 1 Ω
T14-8 (VC5) or T7-1 (VC5) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T14-11 (CODE) or T7-4 (CODE) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T14-12 (TXCT) or T7-5 (TXCT) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T14-13 (AGND) or T7-7 (GND) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
B63404
B55013
B64974
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
5
(a)
CHECK OPERATION OF TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
After replacing the transponder key amplifier with a normally functioning amplifier, check that the engine starts.
NG
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2198
05-2009
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B2797
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
052IL-10
COMMUNICATION MALFUNCTION NO.1
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when an error occurs in normal communication.
HINT:
Some noise exists in the communication line.
DTC No.
B2797
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Keys are positioned too close to each other, or noise occurred in communication line
Key
Wire harness
Transponder key amplifier
Transponder key ECU assy
WIRING DIAGRAM
T7
Transponder Key Amplifier
CODE
T14
Transponder Key ECU Assy
GR
4
11
CODE
B52550
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK OPERATION OF TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
After replacing the transponder key amplifier with a normally functioning amplifier, check that the engine starts.
OK
NORMAL
(TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER DEFECTIVE)
NG
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2199
05-2010
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B2799
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
052IM-12
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when the ECM detects errors in communication between the transponder key ECU assy
and the ECM, or in the communication lines.
This DTC is also output when an engine start is attempted while the ECU communication ID between the
transponder key ECU assy and the ECM is different.
Before troubleshooting for this DTC, make sure that there is no DTC detected in the transponder key ECU.
If there is a key code-related DTC detected in the transponder key ECU assy, repair it first.
DTC No.
B2799
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Error in communication between ECM and transponder
key ECU assy, and in communication line
Communication ID is different during communication with
transponder key ECU
Wire harness
Transponder key ECU assy
Transponder key amplifier
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
T14
Transponder Key ECU Assy
E6
ECM
IMI
IMO
27
B
6
26
V
7
EFIO
EFII
B66227
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2200
05-201 1
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY - ECM)
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY OR ECM - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
T14
Transponder Key ECU Assy
Disconnect the T14 ECU and E6 ECM connectors.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
EFIO (T14-6) - IMI (E6-27)
Below 1 Ω
EFII (T14-7) - IMO (E6-26)
Below 1 Ω
(c)
E6
ECM
Y
B66220
Specified Condition
Measure the resistance between the T14 or E6 wire harness side connector and the body ground.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Specified Condition
EFIO (T14-6) or IMI (E6-27) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
EFII (T14-7) or IMO (E6-26) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
B66229
OK
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
2
(a)
CHECK OPERATION OF TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
After replacing the transponder key amplifier with a normally functioning amplifier, check that the engine starts.
NG
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY
OK
NORMAL (TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER DEFECTIVE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2201
05-1985
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
052IA-27
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Use this procedure to troubleshoot the engine immobilizer system.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK AND SYMPTOM CHECK
(see page 05-1987 )
3
CRANK ENGINE FOR MORE THAN 10 SECONDS
4
CHECK DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output.
Delete the DTC.
Recheck for DTCs. Try to prompt the DTC (SFI system and engine immobilizer system) by simulating
the original activity that the DTC suggested.
(1) If the DTC does not reoccur, proceed to A.
(2) If the DTC (SFI system) reoccurs, proceed to B.
(3) If the DTC (engine immobilizer system) reoccur, proceed to C.
B
Go to SFI SYSTEM
(2AZ-FE engine: See page 05-1 )
(3MZ-FE engine: See page 05-362 )
C
Go to step 8
A
5
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(IMMOBILIZER ECU (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY) (SWITCH CONDITION))
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item ”KEY SW” in the ”DATA LIST” and read its value displayed on the hand-held tester.
Transponder key ECU assy:
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
KEY Switch
Unlock warning switch signal
/ON or OFF
ON: Key is in ignition key cylinder
OFF: No key is in ignition key cylinder
-
NG
Go to DTC B2780 (see page 05-1998 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2175
05-1986
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
OK
6
(a)
(b)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (see page 05-1997 )
When the problem is not listed on the problem symptoms table, proceed to A.
When the problem is listed on the problem symptoms table, proceed to B.
B
Go to step 8
A
7
(a)
PERFORM TROUBLESHOOTING ACCORDING TO MALFUNCTION SYMPTOM
Pre-check (see page 05-1988 )
(1) Inspect with the hand-held tester (ECU data monitor).
(2) Inspect with the hand-held tester (ACTIVE TEST).
Terminals of ECU (see page 05-1993 )
(b)
8
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2176
05-1987
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
052IB-13
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s
:
Name
VIN
Production Date
Customer’s Name
/
/
Licence Plate No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Frequency Problem Occurs
Weather Conditions
When Problem
Occurred
Symptoms
Weather
km
miles
Odometer Reading
/
/
Intermittent (
Constant
times a day/month)
Only once
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Snowy
Various/Others
Outdoor
Temperature
Hot
Warm
Cold (Approx.
C (
Cool
F)
Immobilizer is not set.
(Engine starts with key codes other than the registered key code.)
Engine does not start.
1st Time
Normal code
Malfunction code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal code
Malfunction code (Code
)
DTC Check
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2177
05-1991
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
052ID-13
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
1.
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
B2780
(05-1998 )
Push Switch/Key Unlock Warning Switch Malfunction
Unlock warning switch
Wire harness
Transponder key ECU assy
B2784
(05-2001 )
Antenna Coil Open/Short
Wire harness
Transponder key amplifier
Transponder key ECU assy
B2793
(05-2003 )
Transponder Chip Malfunction
Key
B2794
(05-2004 )
Unmatched Encryption Code
Key
B2795
(05-2005 )
Unmatched Key Code
Key
No Communication in Immobilizer System
Key
Transponder key amplifier
Wire harness
Transponder key ECU assy
B2797
(05-2009 )
Communication Malfunction No. 1
Key
Wire harness
Transponder key amplifier
Transponder key ECU assy
B2798
(05-2006 )
Communication Malfunction No. 2
Key
B2796
(05-2006 )
2.
ECM DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
NOTICE:
The DTC for the immobilizer system is specified. If the other codes are output, check the DTC chart
of the engine control system.
DTC No.
(See Page)
B2799
(05-2010 )
Detection Item
Engine Immobilizer System Malfunction
Trouble Area
Wire harness
Key
Transponder key ECU assy
Transponder key amplifier (Transponder key coil)
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2181
05-1992
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
052IE-12
LOCATION
Transponder Key ECU Assy
Unlock Warning Switch Assy
ECM
Transponder Key Amplifier
B78736
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2182
05-1988
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
05A23-07
PRE-CHECK
1.
(a)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Description
(1) The ECM controls the function of the immobilizer system on this vehicle.
Data of the immobilizer system and the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) can be read in the Data
Link Connector 3 (DLC3) of the vehicle. When trouble occurs in the immobilizer system, even
though the security indicator lamp does not turn on, DTCs can be checked.
Therefore, when there seems to be trouble with the immobilizer system, use the hand-held tester
to check for trouble and troubleshoot it.
(b)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Inspect the DLC3.
The vehicle’s ECM uses the ISO 9141-2 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies
with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 9141-2 format.
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
DLC3
B50154
Standard:
Terminal No.
Condition
Specified Condition
7 (Bus + Line) - 5 (Signal ground)
During communication
Pulse generation
4 (Chassis Ground) - Body ground
Constant
Below 1 Ω
5 (Signal Ground) - Body ground
Constant
Below 1 Ω
16 (B+) - Body ground
Constant
10 to 14 V
HINT:
Connect the cable of the hand-held tester to the DLC3, turn the ignition switch ON and attempt to use the
hand-held tester. If the screen displays UNABLE TO CONNEC TO TO VEHICLE, a problem exists in the
vehicle side or the tester side.
If communication is normal when the tester is connected to other vehicle, inspect the DLC3 of the original vehicle.
If communication is still impossible when the tester is connected to another vehicle, the problem may
be in the tester itself. Consult the Service Department listed in the tester’s instruction manual.
2.
CHECK DIAGNOSIS
(a) Using the hand-held tester, check for DTC.
NOTICE:
Hand-held tester only:
When the diagnosis system is changed from normal mode to check mode, all DTCs and freeze frame
data recorded in normal mode will be erased. Before changing modes, always check the DTCs and
freeze frame data, and make a note of them.
(1) Prepare the hand-held tester.
(2) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 under the instrument panel lower pad.
(3) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester switch ON.
(4) Use the hand-held tester to check for DTCs and freeze frame data, and make a note of them
(for operating instructions, see the hand-held tester instruction book).
(5) Confirm the details of the DTCs.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2178
05-1989
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
Either of the following procedures will erase the DTCs and freeze frame data.
(1) Operating the hand-held tester to erase the codes (see the instruction manual for the hand-held
tester).
(2) Disconnecting the battery terminals or ECU-B fuse.
DATA LIST
3.
HINT:
Using the hand-held tester DATA LIST allows switch, sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in troubleshooting is one way to shorten labor time.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the tester.
Transponder key ECU assy:
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
KEY SW
Unlock warning switch signal/
ON or OFF
IG SW
Ignition switch signal/ ON or OFF
IMMOBILISER
Immobilizer system status/
SET or UNSET
RESPONSE
Transponder chip data/
NG or OK
NG: Data error
OK: Data OK
FRAME
Transponder chip data/
NG or OK
NG: Data error
OK: Data OK
SERIAL NUMBER
Transponder chip data/
NG or OK
NG: Data error
OK: Data OK
ENCRYPT CODE
Transponder chip data/
NG or OK
NG: Data error
OK: Data OK
STATUS
Transponder chip data/
NG or OK
NG: Data error
OK: Data OK
BCC
Transponder chip signal/
NG or OK
SUB KEY
Sub-key code signal/
NOMATCH or MATCH
NOMATCH: Unmatched sub-key code is sent
MATCH: Sub-key code is sent
MASTER KEY
Master key code signal/
NOMATCH or MATCH
NOMATCH: Unmatched master key code is sent
MATCH: Master key code is sent
REGIST SUB CODE
REGIST MAS CODE
Normal Condition
OFF: Key is in ignition key cylinder
ON: No key is in ignition key cylinder
OFF: Ignition switch is in OFF or ACC position
ON: Ignition switch is in ON position
UNSET: Without key
SET: Ignition switch ON
NG: Incorrect data sending
OK: Correct data sending
Number of registered sub-key/ min. 0, max. 15
Number of registered sub-key
Number of registered master key/ min. 0, max. 15 Number of registered master key
REG CODE SPACE
Memory space for key codes
registration/
NOT FUL or FULL
ANTENNA COIL
Antenna coil condition/
NORMAL or FAIL
NOT FUL: Possible to resister more key codes
FULL: Cannot register any more key codes
NORMAL: Antenna coil is normal
FAIL: Antenna coil is malfunctioning
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2179
05-1990
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
4.
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the hand-held tester ACTIVE TEST allows relay, VSV, actuator and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to shorten
labor time. The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST according to the display on the tester.
Transponder key ECU assy:
Item
Test Details
SECURITY INDIC
Turn security indicator ON/OFF
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2180
05-1997
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
052IG-12
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Problem Symptom
Suspected Area
See Page
1. Key
05-2003
05-2004
05-2005
05-2006
05-2009
05-2001
05-2006
05-2010
05-1998
05-2001
05-2006
05-2009
05-2010
2. Transponder key amplifier
Engine does not start
3. Transponder key ECU assy
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2187
05-1993
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
05A27-21
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
T7
B65593
(a)
Disconnect the T7 amplifier connector, and measure the resistance between the terminal of the wire
harness side connector and body ground.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
GND (T7-7) Body ground
R - Body ground
Standard
Below 1 Ω
Constant
If the result is not as specified, there may be a malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the T7 amplifier connector, and measure the resistance and voltage of each terminal of the
connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
VC5 (T7-1) -
Wiring Color
Condition
Standard
B-R
No key in ignition key cylinder → With key
0 V → 10 to 14 V
CODE(T7-4) GND (T7-7)
GR - R
No key in ignition key cylinder → With key
Pulse generation
(see waveform 1)
TXCT (T7-5) GND (T7-7)
W-R
No key in ignition key cylinder → With key
Pulse generation
(see waveform 2)
GND (T7-7) Body ground
R - Body ground
GND (T7-7)
Below 1 Ω
Constant
If the result is not as specified, the amplifier may have a malfunction.
20 ms
5V
(c)
Inspect using an oscilloscope.
Waveform 1 (Reference):
Terminal
CODE - GND
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 20 ms/DIV.
Condition
Ignition switch ON
B55023
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2183
05-1994
DIAGNOSTICS
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
Waveform 2 (Reference):
10 ms
10 V
-
Terminal
TXCT - GND
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 10 ms/DIV.
Condition
Ignition switch ON
B55024
2.
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSY
T14
B50659
(a)
Disconnect the T14 ECU connector, and measure the voltage and resistance between each terminal
of the wire harness side connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
AGND (T14-13) Body ground
Condition
Specified Condition
R - Body ground
Constant
Below 1 Ω
+B (T14-1) GND (T14-14)
P - W-B
Constant
10 to 14 V
IG (T14-2) AGND (T14-13)
P-R
Ignition switch OFF → ON
KSW (T14-10) AGND (T14-13)
G-R
No key in ignition key cylinder → With key
0 V → 10 to 14 V
10 kΩ or higher →
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Reconnect the T14 ECU connector, and measure the voltage between each terminal of the connector.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
KSW (T14-10) AGND (T14-13)
Condition
Specified Condition
G-R
No key in ignition key cylinder → With key
10 to 14 V → 0 V
VC5 (T14-8) AGND (T14-13)
B-R
Ignition switch OFF → ON
0 V → 4.5 to 5.5 V
TXCT (T14-12) AGND (T14-13)
W-R
Ignition switch OFF → ON
Pulse generation
(see waveform 1)
CODE (T14-11) AGND (T14-13)
GR - R
Ignition switch OFF → ON
Pulse generation
(see waveform 2)
EFIO (T14-6) AGND (T14-13)
B-R
Ignition switch OFF → ON
Pulse generation
(see waveform 3)
EFII (T14-7) AGND (T14-13)
V-R
Ignition switch OFF → ON
Pulse generation
(see waveform 4)
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a malfunction.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2184
05-1995
DIAGNOSTICS
5V
20 ms
(c)
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
Inspect using an oscilloscope.
Waveform 1 (Reference):
Terminal
TXCT - GND
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 20 ms/DIV.
Condition
Ignition switch ON
B52544
5V
20 ms
Waveform 2 (Reference):
Terminal
CODE - GND
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 20 ms/DIV.
Condition
Ignition switch ON
B52545
10 V
100 ms
Waveform 3 (Reference):
Terminal
EFIO - GND
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 ms/DIV.
Condition
Ignition switch ON
B52547
10 V
100 ms
Waveform 4 (Reference):
Terminal
EFII - GND
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 ms/DIV.
Condition
Constant
B52548
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2185
05-1996
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
CHECK ECM
E7
E8
E6
E9
E5
B50745
(a)
Disconnect the E6 and E7 ECM connectors, and measure the voltage and resistance between each
terminal of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
IMI (E6-27) E1 (E9-1)*1 (E7-1)*2
B - BR
No key in ignition key cylinder → With key
Pulse generation
(see waveform 1)
IMO (E6-26) E1 (E9-1)*1 (E7-1)*2
V - BR
No key in ignition key cylinder → With key
Pulse generation
(see waveform 2)
E1 (E9-1)*1 (E7-1)*2
Body ground
BR - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Constant
If the result is not as specified, there may be a malfunction on the wire harness side.
*1: 2AZ-FE
*2: 3MZ-FE
10 V
100 ms
(b)
Inspect using an oscilloscope.
Waveform 1 (Reference):
Terminal
IMI - GND
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 ms/DIV.
Condition
Ignition switch ON
B52547
10 V
100 ms
Waveform 2 (Reference):
Terminal
IMO - GND
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 ms/DIV.
Condition
Constant
B52548
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2186
05-1233
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525D-05
B0100/13 SHORT IN D SQUIB CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center, the spiral cable sub-assy and the horn button
assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0100/13 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the D squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0100/13
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between D+ wire harness and D- wire harness of D squib
D squib malfunction
Spiral cable sub-assy malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Horn button assy (D squib)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
D Squib
2
1
Y-B
14
A17 D+
1
2
Y
13
A17 D-
1
4
Y-R
16
A17 D2+
2
3
Y-G
17
A17 D2-
A20
Spiral Cable
Sub-assy
H43063
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1423
05-1234
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
CHECK CONNECTOR
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the horn button assy.
Check that the spiral cable sub-assy connectors (on the horn button assy side) are not damaged.
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, or the claw of the lock is not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-26 )
OK
2
CHECK D SQUIB CIRCUIT(AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER - HORN BUTTON
ASSY)
(a)
D Squib
F
E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D C
B
Airbag
A Sensor
Assy
Center
D-
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the connector from the airbag sensor assy
center.
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”B” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - D-
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
D+
Color: Black
H01001
C89244
H41475
NG
Go to step 5
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1424
05-1235
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
D Squib
F
E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D C
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
DTC B0100/13
DLC3
(g)
CG
H01002
H10600 H40103
TC
H40030
Connect the connectors to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0100/13 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0100/13 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1425
05-1236
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK HORN BUTTON ASSY(D SQUIB)
D Squib
F
E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D C
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
DTC B0100/13
CG
(i)
TC
H01003
H10600
H40103
(f)
(g)
(h)
H40031
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the connectors to the horn button assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0100/13 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0100/13 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE HORN BUTTON ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-17 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1426
05-1237
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK COWL WIRE
Cowl Wire
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D
C
B
(a)
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
A20
Disconnect the cowl wire connector from the spiral cable
sub-assy .
HINT:
The activation prevention mechanism of connector ”B” has already been released.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
D+
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A20-1 (D+) - A20-2 (D-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
D-
NG
H43066
H41440
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
6
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(a)
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(b)
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”D” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - D-
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
DD+
Color: Black
NG
H01000
C89244
H41479
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-26 )
0K
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1427
05-1238
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525E-04
B0101/14 OPEN IN D SQUIB CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center, the spiral cable sub-assy and the horn button
assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0101/14 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the D squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0101/14
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in D+ wire harness or D- wire harness of D
squib
D squib malfunction
Spiral cable sub-assy malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Horn button assy (D squib)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1233 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK D SQUIB CIRCUIT(AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER - HORN BUTTON
ASSY)
(a)
(b)
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
D-
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the horn button assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - D-
Always
Below 1 Ω
D+
Color: Black
H01001
C89244
H41475
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1428
05-1239
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D-
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D+
Service Wire
Color: Black
DTC B0101/14
DLC3
CG
H01002
C89252
H10600 W02044
TC
H44124
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
(b) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D- of connector ”E”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0101/14 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0101/14 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1429
05-1240
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK HORN BUTTON ASSY(D SQUIB)
(a)
(b)
D Squib
FE
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
DTC B0101/14
DLC3
(g)
(h)
(i)
CG
TC
H01003
H10600 W02044
H40036
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Connect the connectors to the horn button assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0101/14 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0101/14 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE HORN BUTTON ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-17 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1430
05-1241
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK COWL WIRE
(a)
Cowl Wire
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(b)
A20
Disconnect the cowl wire connector from the spiral cable
sub-assy .
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A20-1 (D+) - A20-2 (D-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
D+
DH41440
NG
H43066
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
5
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(a)
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - D-
Always
Below 1 Ω
DD+
Color: Black
NG
H01000
C89244
H41479
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-26 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1431
05-1242
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525F-20
B0102/11 SHORT IN D SQUIB CIRCUIT (TO GROUND)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center, the spiral cable sub-assy and the horn button
assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0102/11 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the D squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0102/11
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in D squib wire harness (to ground)
D squib malfunction
Spiral cable sub-assy malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Horn button assy (D squib)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1233 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK D SQUIB CIRCUIT(AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER - HORN BUTTON
ASSY)
(a)
(b)
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
DD+
Color: Black
H01001
C89244
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the horn button assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
D- - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
H41475
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1432
05-1243
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D+
D-
Service Wire
Color: Black
DLC3
CG
H01002
C89252
H10600 C91338
DTC B0102/11
TC
H44123
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
(b) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D- of connector ”E”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0102/11 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0102/11 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1433
05-1244
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK HORN BUTTON ASSY(D SQUIB)
(a)
(b)
D Squib
FE
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
DTC B0102/11
DLC3
(g)
(h)
(i)
CG
H01003
H10600 W02042
TC
H40037
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Connect the connectors to the horn button assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0102/11 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0102/11 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE HORN BUTTON ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-17 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1434
05-1245
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK COWL WIRE
(a)
Cowl Wire
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(b)
A20
D+
Disconnect the cowl wire connector from the spiral cable
sub-assy .
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A20-1 (D+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A20-2 (D-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
D-
NG
H43066
H41440
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
5
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(a)
Cowl Wire
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
D- - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
DD+
Color: Black
NG
H01000
C89244
H41479
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-26 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1435
05-1246
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525G-17
B0103/12 SHORT IN D SQUIB CIRCUIT (TO B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center, the spiral cable sub-assy and the horn button
assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0103/12 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the D squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0103/12
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in D squib wire harness (to B+)
D squib malfunction
Spiral cable sub-assy malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Horn button assy (D squib)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1233 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK D SQUIB CIRCUIT(AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER - HORN BUTTON
ASSY)
(a)
(b)
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(d)
(e)
(f)
DD+
Color: Black
H01001
C89244
(c)
H41475
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the horn button assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
D- - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1436
05-1247
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
H42141
(a)
(b)
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D-
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D+
Service Wire
Color: Black
DTC B0103/12
DLC3
CG
H01002
C89252
H10600
TC
H44122
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
(d) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D- of connector ”E”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j)
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0103/12 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0103/12 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1437
05-1248
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK HORN BUTTON ASSY(D SQUIB)
(a)
(b)
D Squib
FE
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
DLC3
CG
DTC B0103/12
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H01003
H10600 W02043
H40038
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Connect the connectors to the horn button assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0103/12 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0103/12 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE HORN BUTTON ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-17 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1438
05-1249
DIAGNOSTICS
4
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
A20
(e)
(f)
D+
DH41440
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK COWL WIRE
Cowl Wire
D Squib
-
H43066
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the cowl wire connector from the spiral cable
sub-assy .
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A20-1 (D+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A20-2 (D-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1439
05-1250
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(a)
Cowl Wire
D Squib
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below when the ignition switch is in the ON position.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D+ - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
D- - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
DD+
Color: Black
H01000
C89244
H41479
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-26 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1440
05-1251
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525H-05
B0105/53 SHORT IN P SQUIB CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front passenger airbag assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0105/53 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the P squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0105/53
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between P+ wire harness and P- wire harness of P squib
P squib malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Front passenger airbag assy (P squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
A19
P Squib
Y-B
1
Y
2
10
A17
P+
11
A17
P-
H01454
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1441
05-1252
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK COWL WIRE(P SQUIB CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Cowl Wire
P Squib
D
C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
A19
(e)
P+
P-
R14286
H41424
H41932
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front passenger airbag assy.
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”B” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A19-1 (P+) A19-2 (P-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
2
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
P Squib
D C
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
DTC B0105/53
DLC3
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
CG
H01023
H10600 H01077
TC
H42107
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0105/53 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0105/53 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1442
05-1253
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY(P SQUIB)
(a)
(b)
P Squib
DC
DLC3
CG
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DTC B0105/53
(f)
(g)
(h)
TC
H01024
H10600 H01077
H40041
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the connector to the front passenger airbag
assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0105/53 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0105/53 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-29 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1443
05-1254
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525I-04
B0106/54 OPEN IN P SQUIB CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front passenger airbag assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0106/54 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the P squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in P+ wire harness or P- wire harness of P
squib
P squib malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0106/54
Front passenger airbag assy (P squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1251 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK COWL WIRE(P SQUIB CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Cowl Wire
P Squib
D
C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
A19
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front passenger airbag assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A19-1 (P+) - A19-2 (P-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
P+
R14286
H41424
P-
H41932
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1444
05-1255
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Cowl Wire
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D C
(c)
A19
(d)
P-
(e)
(f)
(g)
P+
SST
DLC3
DTC B0106/54
HINT:
Codes other than code B0106/54 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
CG
H01023
H16855
H10600 H01078
(h)
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using SST, connect A19-1 (P+) and A19-2 (P-) of connector ”C”.
SST 09843-18040
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0106/54 is not output.
TC
H41934
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1445
05-1256
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY(P SQUIB)
(a)
(b)
P Squib
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
DTC B0106/54
(g)
(h)
(i)
CG
TC
H01024
H10600 H01078
(f)
H40043
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the SST from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the front passenger airbag
assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0106/54 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0106/54 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-29 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1446
05-1257
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525J-17
B0107/51 SHORT IN P SQUIB CIRCUIT (TO GROUND)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front passenger airbag assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0107/51 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the P squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P squib wire harness (to ground)
P squib malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0107/51
Front passenger airbag assy (P squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1251 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK COWL WIRE(P SQUIB CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Cowl Wire
P Squib
D
C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
A19
P+
R14286
H41424
P-
H41932
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front passenger airbag assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A19-1 (P+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A19-2 (P-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1447
05-1258
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Cowl Wire
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D C
(c)
A19
(d)
PP+
(e)
(f)
(g)
SST
DTC B0107/51
DLC3
HINT:
Codes other than code B0107/51 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
CG
H01023
H40538 H40579
H10600 H01075
(h)
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using SST, connect A19-1 (P+) and A19-2(P-) of connector ”C”.
SST 09843-18040
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0107/51 is not output.
TC
H44680
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1448
05-1259
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY(P SQUIB)
(a)
(b)
P Squib
DC
DLC3
CG
H01024
H10600
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DTC B0107/51
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H01075
(f)
H40045
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the SST from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the front passenger airbag
assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0107/51 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0107/51 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-29 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1449
05-1260
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525K-17
B0108/52 SHORT IN P SQUIB CIRCUIT (TO B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front passenger airbag assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0108/52 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the P squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
B0108/52
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P squib wire harness (to B+)
P squib malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Front passenger airbag assy (P squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1251 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK COWL WIRE(P SQUIB CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Cowl Wire
P Squib
D
C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
A19
P+
R14286
H41424
P-
H41932
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front passenger airbag assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A19-1 (P+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A19-2 (P-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1450
05-1261
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Cowl Wire
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
P Squib
D C
A19
(c)
(d)
P-
(e)
P+
(f)
SST
DLC3
DTC B0108/52
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
CG
H01023
H40538
H10600
TC
H01076
H40581
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using SST, connect A19-1 (P+) and A19-2 (P-) of connector ”C”.
SST 09843-18040
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0108/52 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0108/52 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1451
05-1262
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY(P SQUIB)
(a)
(b)
P Squib
DC
DLC3
CG
H01024
H10600
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
DTC B0108/52
(f)
(e)
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H01076
H40047
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the SST from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the front passenger airbag
assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0108/52 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0108/52 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-29 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1452
05-1263
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525L-04
B0110/43 SHORT IN SIDE SQUIB (RH) CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib RH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the separate type front seat back
assy (side squib RH).
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0110/43 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the side squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
B0110/43
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between SFR+ wire harness and SFR- wire
harness of side squib RH
Side squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Separate type front seat back assy (Side squib RH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
S19
Side Squib (RH)
1
Y-B
(*1)
2
Y
(*1)
5
A18 SFR+
6
A18 SFR-
*1: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
H01454
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1453
05-1264
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(SIDE SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Side Squib RH
C
A
D
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
B
(c)
(d)
S19
(e)
SFR-
SFR+
H40977
H01019
H42497
H42849
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the separate type front seat back assy (side
squib RH).
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”B” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S19-1 (SFR+) S19-2 (SFR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Side Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
D C
DLC3
DTC B0110/43
(g)
CG
H01020
H10600
H01069
TC
H42111
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0110/43 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0110/43 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1454
05-1265
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT BACK ASSY(SIDE SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
Side Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
DC
DLC3
(e)
DTC B0110/43
(f)
(g)
(h)
CG
H01021
H10600
H01069
TC
H40979
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the connector to the separate type front seat
back assy (side squib RH).
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0110/43 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0110/43 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT
BACK ASSY(SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1455
05-1266
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525M-04
B0111/44 OPEN IN SIDE SQUIB (RH) CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib RH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the separate type front seat back
assy (side squib RH).
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0111/44 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the side squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in SFR+ wire harness or SFR- wire harness
of side squib RH
Side squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0111/44
Separate type front seat back assy (Side squib RH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1263 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(SIDE SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Side Squib RH
C
A
D
SFR+
H40977
H01019
H42497
B
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
S19
SFR-
H42849
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait at least for 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the separate type front seat back assy (side
squib RH).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S19-1 (SFR+) S19-2 (SFR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1456
05-1267
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
Side Squib RH C
D
S19
SFR+
SFR-
Service Wire
DLC3
CG
H01020
H42496
H10600 H01070
DTC B0111/44
TC
H42850
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect S19-1 (SFR+) and S19-2
(SFR-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0111/44 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0111/44 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1457
05-1268
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT BACK ASSY(SIDE SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
Side Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DC
DLC3
CG
H01021
H10600 H01070
DTC B0111/44
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H40981
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the separate type front seat
back assy (side squib RH).
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0111/44 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0111/44 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT
BACK ASSY (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1458
05-1269
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525N-16
B0112/41 SHORT IN SIDE SQUIB (RH) CIRCUIT (TO
GROUND)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib RH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the separate type front seat back
assy (side squib RH).
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0112/41 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the side squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in side squib (RH) wire harness (to ground)
Side squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0112/41
Separate type front seat back assy (Side squib RH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1263 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(SIDE SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Side Squib RH
C
A
D
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
B
S19
SFR+
H40977
H01019
H42497
SFR-
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the separate type front seat back assy (side
squib RH).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S19-1 (SFR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
S19-2 (SFR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
H42849
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1459
05-1270
DIAGNOSTICS
2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
Side Squib RH C
D
S19
SFR+
SFR-
Service Wire
DLC3
CG
H01020
H42496
H10600
-
H01067
DTC B0112/41
TC
H42851
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect S19-1 (SFR+) and S19-2
(SFR-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0112/41 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0112/41 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1460
05-1271
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT BACK ASSY(SIDE SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
Side Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DC
DLC3
CG
DTC B0112/41
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H01021
H10600 H01067
(f)
H40983
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the separate type front seat
back assy (side squib RH).
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0112/41 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0112/41 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT
BACK ASSY (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1461
05-1272
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525O-17
B0113/42 SHORT IN SIDE SQUIB (RH) CIRCUIT (TO
B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib RH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the separate type front seat back
assy (side squib RH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0113/42 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the side squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in side squib (RH) wire harness (to B+)
Side squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0113/42
Separate type front seat back assy (Side squib RH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1263 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(SIDE SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Side Squib RH
C
A
D
SFR+
H40977
H01019
H42497
B
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
S19
(e)
(f)
SFR-
H42849
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the separate type front seat back assy (side
squib RH).
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S19-1 (SFR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
S19-2 (SFR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1462
05-1273
DIAGNOSTICS
2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Side Squib RH
S19
C
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D
SFR+
SFRService Wire
DLC3
CG
H01020
H42496
H10600
-
H01068
DTC B0113/42
TC
H42852
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
(d) Using a service wire, connect S19-1 (SFR+) and S19-2
(SFR-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j)
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0113/42 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0113/42 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1463
05-1274
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT BACK ASSY(SIDE SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
Side Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DC
DLC3
CG
DTC B0113/42
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H01021
H10600 H01068
(f)
H40985
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the separate type front seat
back assy (side squib RH).
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0113/42 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0113/42 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT
BACK ASSY (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1464
05-1275
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525P-04
B0115/47 SHORT IN SIDE SQUIB (LH) CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the separate type front seat back
assy (side squib LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0115/47 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the side squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
B0115/47
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between SFL+ wire harness and SFL- wire
harness of side squib LH
Side squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Separate type front seat back assy (Side squib LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
S18
Side Squib LH
1
Y-B
(*1)
2
Y
(*1)
12
A16 SFL+
11
A16 SFL-
*1: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
H01454
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1465
05-1276
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(SIDE SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
Side Squib LH
A
D
C
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
B
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
S18
(d)
SFL+
(e)
SFL-
H01016
H42497
H42853
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the separate type front seat back assy (side
squib LH).
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”B” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S18-1 (SFL+) S18-2 (SFL-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Side Squib LH
D C
(c)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(d)
(e)
(f)
DLC3
DTC B0115/47
CG
(g)
TC
H01017
H10600 H01073
H42153
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0115/47 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0115/47 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1466
05-1277
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT BACK ASSY(SIDE SQUIB LH)
(a)
(b)
Side Squib LH
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
DTC B0115/47
CG
(f)
(g)
(h)
TC
H01018
H10600
H01073
H40988
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the connector to the separate type front seat
back assy (side squib LH).
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0115/47 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0115/47 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT
BACK ASSY (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1467
05-1278
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525Q-04
B0116/48 OPEN IN SIDE SQUIB (LH) CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the separate type front seat back
assy (side squib LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0116/48 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the side squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in SFL+ wire harness or SFL- wire harness
of side squib LH
Side squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0116/48
Separate type front seat back assy (Side squib LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1275 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(SIDE SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
Side Squib LH
A
D
C
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
B
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
S18
SFL+
H01016
H42497
SFL-
H42853
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the separate type front seat back assy (side
squib LH).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S18-1 (SFL+) S18-2 (SFL-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1468
05-1279
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
D
S18
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
Side Squib LH
C
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
SFL-
SFL+
Service Wire
DLC3
CG
DTC B0116/48
TC
H01017
H42496
H10600 H01074
H42854
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect S18-1 (SFL+) and S18-2
(SFL-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0116/48 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0116/48 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1469
05-1280
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT BACK ASSY(SIDE SQUIB LH)
(a)
(b)
Side Squib LH
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
CG
DTC B0116/48
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H01018
H10600
H01074
(f)
H40990
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the separate type front seat
back assy (side squib LH).
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0116/48 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0116/48 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT
BACK ASSY (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1470
05-1281
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525R-17
B0117/45 SHORT IN SIDE SQUIB (LH) CIRCUIT (TO
GROUND)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the separate type front seat back
assy (side squib LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0117/45 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the side squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in side squib (LH) wire harness (to ground)
Side squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0117/45
Separate type front seat back assy (Side squib LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Fioor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1275 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(SIDE SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
Side Squib LH
A
D
C
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
B
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
S18
SFL+
H01016
H42497
SFL-
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the separate type front seat back assy (side
squib LH).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S18-1 (SFL+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
S18-2 (SFL-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
H42853
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1471
05-1282
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Side Squib LH
D C
S18
SFL+
Floor Wire No.2
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
SFL-
Service Wire
DLC3
CG
DTC B0117/45
TC
H01017
H42496
H10600 H01071
H42855
(a)
(b)
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect S18-1 (SFL+) and S18-2
(SFL-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0117/45 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0117/45 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1472
05-1283
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT BACK ASSY(SIDE SQUIB LH)
(a)
(b)
Side Squib LH
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
CG
DTC B0117/45
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H01018
H10600 H01071
(f)
H40992
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the separate type front seat
back assy (side squib LH).
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0117/45 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0117/45 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT
BACK ASSY(SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1473
05-1284
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525S-16
B0118/46 SHORT IN SIDE SQUIB (LH) CIRCUIT (TO
B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the separate type front seat back
assy (side squib LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0118/46 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the side squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in side squib (LH) wire harness (to B+)
Side squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0118/46
Separate type front seat back assy (Side squib LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1275 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(SIDE SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
Side Squib LH
A
D
C
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
B
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
S18
SFL+
H01016
H42497
(e)
(f)
SFL-
H42853
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the separate type front seat back assy (side
squib LH).
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S18-1 (SFL+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
S18-2 (SFL-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1474
05-1285
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D C
S18
SFL+
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
Side Squib LH
SFL-
Service Wire
DLC3
CG
DTC B0118/46
TC
H01017
H42496
H10600 H01072
H42856
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
(d) Using a service wire, connect S18-1 (SFL+) and S18-2
(SFL-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j)
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0118/46 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0118/46 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1475
05-1286
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT BACK ASSY(SIDE SQUIB LH)
(a)
(b)
Side Squib LH
DC
DLC3
CG
(c)
(d)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(e)
DTC B0118/46
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H01018
H10600 H01072
(f)
H40994
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the separate type front seat
back assy (side squib LH).
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0118/46 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0118/46 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT
BACK ASSY (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1476
05-1287
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVB-01
B0126/27 SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH (LH)
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The seat belt buckle switch LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front seat inner belt
assy LH (seat belt buckle switch LH).
DTC B0126/27 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the seat belt buckle switch LH circuit.
DTC No.
B0126/27
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in front seat inner belt assy LH wire harness
(to B+)
Short circuit in front seat inner belt assy LH wire harness
(to ground)
Open circuit in LBE+ wire harness or LBE- wire harness
of front seat inner belt assy LH
Front seat inner belt assy LH malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Front seat inner belt assy LH (Seat belt buckle switch LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
B19
Buckle SW (Driver’s Side)
Airbag Sensor
Assy Center
G
1
R
3
19 11
A16 A16
(*1) (*2)
LBE+
6
2
A16 A16
(*1) (*2)
LBE-
*1: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/o Curtain Shield Airbag
H43056
H44106
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1477
05-1288
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a)
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy LH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
DTC B0126/27
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0126/27 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0126/27 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
CG
TC
C85269
H10600
C85273
H41027
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the airbag sensor assy center and the front seat
inner belt assy LH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1478
05-1289
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(OPEN)
(a)
Floor Wire No.2
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D
C
B
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy LH
Service Wire
B19
1
A16
LBE(*1)
LBE+
3
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front seat inner belt assy LH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect B19-1 and B19-3 of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminal of the
connector when connecting.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
w/ Curtain shield airbag (*1):
LBE-
A16
(*2)
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-19 (LBE+) A16-2 (LBE-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
w/o Curtain shield airbag (*2):
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-11 (LBE+) A16-6 (LBE-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
LBE+
H43342
H42459
H44468
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(TO B+)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy LH
LBE-
A16
(*2)
(*1)
A16
LBELBE+
LBE+
H42459
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
w/ Curtain shield airbag (*1):
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-19 (LBE+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A16-2 (LBE-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
w/o Curtain shield airbag (*2):
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-11 (LBE+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A16-6 (LBE-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1479
05-1290
DIAGNOSTICS
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(TO GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy LH
LBE-
-
(*1)
A16
LBE-
A16
(*2)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
w/ Curtain shield airbag (*1):
LBE+
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-19 (LBE+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A16-2 (LBE-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
w/o Curtain shield airbag (*2):
LBE+
H42459
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-11 (LBE+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A16-6 (LBE-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(SHORT)
(a)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
w/ Curtain shield airbag (*1):
Floor Wire No.2
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy LH
LBE-
A16
(*2)
(*1)
A16
LBELBE+
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-19 (LBE+) A16-2 (LBE-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
w/o Curtain shield airbag (*2):
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-11 (LBE+) A16-6 (LBE-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
LBE+
H42459
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1480
05-1291
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY LH
(a)
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy LH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
DTC B0126/27
DLC3
(g)
CG
C85269
H10600
TC
C85273
H41027
Connect the connectors to the front seat inner belt assy
LH and the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0126/27 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0126/27 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1481
05-1292
DIAGNOSTICS
8
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY LH
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the front seat inner belt assy LH (see page 72-1 1, 72-19 ).
9
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy LH
C85269
H10600
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
DTC B0126/27
DLC3
CG
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(f)
TC
C85273
H41027
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0126/27 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0126/27 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1482
05-1293
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525T-05
B0130/63 SHORT IN P/T SQUIB (RH) CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib RH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front seat outer belt assy RH (seat
belt pretensioner RH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0130/63 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the P/T squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
B0130/63
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between PR+ wire harness and PR- wire
harness of squib
P/T squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Front seat outer belt assy RH (P/T squib RH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
P14
P/T Squib (RH)
Y-B
9
5
A18 A18 PR+
(*1) (*2)
1
Y
2
10
6
A18 A18 PR(*1) (*2)
*1: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/o Curtain Shield Airbag
H01454
H44107
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1483
05-1294
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
CHECK CONNECTOR
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the front seat outer belt assy RH.
Check that the floor wire connector (on the front seat outer belt assy RH side) is not damaged.
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, or the claw of the lock is not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(P/T SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a)
Floor Wire
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
P/T Squib RH
D C
(b)
(c)
B
P14
PR+
H01019
H43108
PR-
H43135
Disconnect the connector from the airbag sensor assy
center.
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”B” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P14-1 (PR+) P14-2 (PR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1484
05-1295
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
P/T Squib RH
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
D C
DLC3
DTC B0130/63
(g)
CG
H01020
H10600 H01082
TC
H42114
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0130/63 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0130/63 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1485
05-1296
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH(P/T SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
P/T Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DC
DLC3
CG
DTC B0130/63
TC
H01021
H10600 H01082
H40050
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the connector to the front seat outer belt assy
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0130/63 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0130/63 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 61-4 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1486
05-1297
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525U-05
B0131/64 OPEN IN P/T SQUIB (RH) CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib RH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front seat outer belt assy RH (seat
belt pretensioner RH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0131/64 is recorded when an open circuit detected in the P/T squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in PR+ wire harness or PR- wire harness of
squib
P/T squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0131/64
Front seat outer belt assy RH (P/T squib RH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1293 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(P/T SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
P/T Squib RH
D C
(c)
(d)
B
P14
PR+
H01019
H43108
PR-
H43135
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait at least for 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front seat outer belt assy RH.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P14-1 (PR+) P14-2 (PR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1487
05-1298
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
P/T Squib (RH)
C
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D
P14
PR+
DLC3
PR-
DTC B0131/64
CG TC
H01020
H43107
H10600 H01083
H46293
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect P14-1 (PR+) and P14-2
(PR-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0131/64 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0131/64 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1488
05-1299
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH(P/T SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
P/T Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DC
DLC3
(f)
DTC B0131/64
(g)
(h)
(i)
CG TC
H01021
H10600
H01083
H40051
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the front seat outer belt assy
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0131/64 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0131/64 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 61-4 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1489
05-1300
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525V-19
B0132/61 SHORT IN P/T SQUIB (RH) CIRCUIT (TO
GROUND)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib RH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front seat outer belt assy RH (seat
belt pretensioner RH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0132/61 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the P/T squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P/T squib (RH) wire harness (to ground)
P/T squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0132/61
Front seat outer belt assy RH (P/T squib RH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1293 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(P/T SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
P/T Squib RH
D C
(c)
(d)
B
P14
PR+
H01019
H43108
PR-
H43135
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait at least for 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front seat outer belt assy RH.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P14-1 (PR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
P14-2 (PR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1490
05-1301
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
P/T Squib RH
D
C
P14
PR+
PRService Wire
DTC B0132/61
DLC3
CG
H01020
H43107
H10600 H01079
TC
H43137
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect P14-1 (PR+) and P14-2
(PR-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0132/61 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0132/61 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1491
05-1302
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH(P/T SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
P/T Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DC
DTC B0132/61
DLC3
CG
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H01021
H10600 H01079
(f)
H40053
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the front seat outer belt assy
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0132/61 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0132/61 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 61-4 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1492
05-1303
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525W-19
B0133/62 SHORT IN P/T SQUIB (RH) CIRCUIT (TO B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib RH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front seat outer belt assy RH (seat
belt pretensioner RH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0133/62 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the P/T squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in seat belt pretensioner (RH) wire harness
(to B+)
P/T squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0133/62
Front seat outer belt assy RH (P/T squib RH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1293 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(P/T SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
P/T Squib RH
D C
(c)
(d)
B
(e)
(f)
P14
PR+
H01019
H43108
PR-
H43135
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front seat outer belt assy RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P14-1 (PR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
P14-2 (PR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1493
05-1304
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
P/T Squib RH
P14
PR+
C
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D
PRService Wire
DLC3
CG
H01020
H43107
H10600 H01081
DTC B0133/62
TC
H43138
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
(d) Using a service wire, connect P14-1 (PR+) and P14-2
(PR-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminal of the connector when connecting.
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j)
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0133/62 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0133/62 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1494
05-1305
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH(P/T SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
P/T Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
DTC B0133/62
(f)
(e)
DC
DLC3
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
CG
H01021
H10600
H01081
H40055
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the front seat outer belt assy
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0133/62 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0133/62 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 61-4 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1495
05-1306
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525X-04
B0135/73 SHORT IN P/T SQUIB (LH) CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front seat outer belt assy LH (seat
belt pretensioner LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0135/73 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the P/T squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
B0135/73
Short circuit between PL+ wire harness and PL- wire harness of P/T squib LH
P/T squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Front seat outer belt assy LH (P/T squib LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
P13
P/T Squib (LH)
Y-B
1
Y
2
2
8
A16
PL+
A16
(*1) (*2)
7
1
A16 A16 PL(*1) (*2)
*1: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/o Curtain Shield Airbag
H01454
H44104
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1496
05-1307
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
CHECK CONNECTOR
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connector from the front seat outer belt assy LH.
Check that the floor wire No.2 connector (on the front seat outer belt assy LH side) is not damaged.
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, or the claw of the lock is not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(P/T SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
(a)
P/T Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(b)
(c)
P13
PL+
H01016
H43108
PL-
H43139
Disconnect the connector from the airbag sensor assy
center.
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”B” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P13-1 (PL+) P13-2 (PL-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1497
05-1308
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
P/T Squib LH
D C
DLC3
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
DTC B0135/73
(g)
CG
TC
H01017
H10600 H01086
H40057
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0135/73 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0135/73 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1498
05-1309
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY LH(P/T SQUIB LH)
(a)
(b)
P/T Squib LH
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
DTC B0135/73
(f)
(g)
(h)
CG
H01018
H10600 H01086
TC
H40058
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the connector to the front seat outer belt assy
LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0135/73 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0135/73 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY LH
(SEE PAGE 61-4 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1499
05-1310
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525Y-04
B0136/74 OPEN IN P/T SQUIB (LH) CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front seat outer belt assy LH (seat
belt pretensioner LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0136/74 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the P/T squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in PL+ wire harness or PL- wire harness of
P/T squib LH
P/T squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0136/74
Front seat outer belt assy LH (P/T squib LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1306 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(P/T SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
P/T Squib LH
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
D C
B
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
P13
PL+
H01016
H43108
PL-
H43139
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front seat outer belt assy LH.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P13-1 (PL+) P13-2 (PL-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1500
05-131 1
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
P/T Squib LH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D C
P13
PL+
PLService Wire
DLC3
CG
H01017
H43107
H10600
DTC B0136/74
TC
H01087
H43140
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect P13-1 (PL+) and P13-2
(PL-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminal of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0136/74 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0136/74 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1501
05-1312
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY LH(P/T SQUIB LH)
(a)
(b)
P/T Squib LH
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
DTC B0136/74
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
CG
H01018
H10600 H01087
(f)
H40060
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the front seat outer belt assy
LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0136/74 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0136/74 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY LH
(SEE PAGE 61-4 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1502
05-1313
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525Z-19
B0137/71 SHORT IN P/T SQUIB (LH) CIRCUIT (TO
GROUND)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front seat outer belt assy LH (seat
belt pretensioner LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0137/71 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the P/T squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P/T squib (LH) wire harness (to ground)
P/T squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0137/71
Front seat outer belt assy LH (P/T squib LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1306 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(P/T SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
P/T Squib LH
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
D C
B
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
P13
PL+
H01016
H43108
PL-
H43139
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect negative (-) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connector from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front seat outer belt assy LH.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P13-1 (PL+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
P13-2 (PL-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1503
05-1314
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
P/T Squib LH
D
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
C
P13
PL+
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
PLService Wire
DLC3
CG
H01017
H43107
H10600
DTC B0137/71
TC
H01084
H43141
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect P13-1 (PL+) and P13-2
(PL-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminal of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0137/71 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0137/71 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1504
05-1315
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY LH(P/T SQUIB LH)
(a)
(b)
P/T Squib LH
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
DTC B0137/71
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
CG
H01018
H10600 H01084
(f)
H40062
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the front seat outer belt assy
LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0137/71 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0137/71 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY LH
(SEE PAGE 61-4 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1505
05-1316
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05260-19
B0138/72 SHORT IN P/T SQUIB (LH) CIRCUIT (TO B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front seat outer belt assy LH (seat
belt pretensioner LH).
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B0137/71 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the P/T squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in seat belt pretensioner (LH) wire harness
(to B+)
P/T squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B0138/72
Front seat outer belt assy LH (P/T squib LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1306 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(P/T SQUIB CIRCUIT)
P/T Squib LH
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
D C
B
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
P13
PL+
H01016
H43108
(e)
(f)
PL-
H43139
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait at least for 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front seat outer belt assy LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P13-1 (PL+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
P13-2 (PL-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1506
05-1317
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
P/T Squib LH Floor Wire No.2
D
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
C
P13
PL-
PL+
Service Wire
DLC3
CG
H01017
H43107
H10600
DTC B0138/72
TC
H01085
H43142
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
(d) Using a service wire, connect P13-1 (PL+) and P13-2
(PL-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminal of the connector when connecting.
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j)
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0138/72 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0138/72 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1507
05-1318
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY LH(P/T SQUIB LH)
(a)
(b)
P/T Squib LH
DC
DLC3
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DTC B0138/72
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
CG
H01018
H10600 H01085
(f)
H40064
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the front seat outer belt assy
LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B0138/72 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0138/72 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY LH
(SEE PAGE 61-4 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1508
05-1319
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVG-01
B1100/31 AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The airbag sensor assy center consists of a airbag sensor assy center, safing sensor, drive circuit, diagnosis
circuit and ignition control, etc.
It receives signals from the airbag sensor, judges whether or not the SRS must be activated, and detects
diagnosis system malfunction.
DTC B1100/31 is recorded when occurrence of a malfunction in the airbag sensor assy center is detected.
DTC No.
B1100/31
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center
HINT:
When a trouble code is displayed simultaneously with B1100/31, repair the malfunction indicated by this
code (except B1100/31) first.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
DLC3
DTC B1100/31
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
CG
H10600
TC
H41086
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1100/31 is not output.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1509
05-1320
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05262-05
B1135/24 HALF CONNECTION IN AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSY CENTER CONNECTORS
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The airbag sensor assy center detects partial connection of connector.
DTC B1135/24 is recorded when the airbag sensor assy center detects an open in the electrical connection
check mechanism of the airbag sensor connector or in the airbag sensor circuit.
DTC No.
B1135/24
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Malfunction of electrical connection check mechanism of
airbag sensor assy center connector
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Electrical connection check mechanism
Airbag sensor assy center
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER CONNECTOR
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check the connection of the airbag sensor assy center connectors.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
HINT:
When the connectors are not firmly connected, disconnect them once and reconnect them securely.
2
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
DLC3
CG
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
DTC B1135/24
TC
H40997
(f)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait at least for 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1135/24 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1135/24 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1510
05-1321
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PERFORM A VISUAL CHECK OF THE DISCONNECTION DETECTION PIN
w/o Side and Curtain Shield Airbag:
Disconnection Detection Pin
(a) Check the disconnection detection pin of the connector.
HINT:
Compare one connector with the other 2 connectors.
OK:
No deformation is identified.
w/ Side and Curtain Shield Airbag:
Disconnection Detection Pin
C83399
C81406
H41456
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY
CENTER CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 60-53 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1511
05-1322
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVK-01
B1140/32 SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY (RH)
MALFUNCTION
The side airbag sensor assy RH consists of the safing sensor, diagnosis circuit and lateral deceleration sensor, etc.
It receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor, judges whether or not the SRS must be activated,
and detects diagnosis system malfunction.
DTC B1140/32 is recorded when occurrence of a malfunction in the side airbag sensor assy RH (RH) is detected.
DTC No.
B1140/32
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Side airbag sensor assy RH
Floor wire
Airbag sensor assy center
Side airbag sensor assy RH circuit malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
S17
Side Airbag Sensor Assy RH
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
1
B
(*1)
4
W
(*1)
3
G
(*1)
2
R
(*1)
ESR
VUPR
SSR+
SSR-
15
A18 ESR
17
A18 VUPR
16
A18 SSR+
13
A18 SSR-
*1: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
H43054
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1512
05-1323
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a)
Side
Airbag
Sensor
Assy RH
DLC3
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
DTC B1140/32
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1140/32 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1140/32 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
CG
TC
H01012
H10600 H01065
H40442
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait at least for 90 seconds.
Check that the connector is properly connected to the airbag sensor assy center and the side airbag
sensor assy RH.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1513
05-1324
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(OPEN)
(a)
Side Airbag Floor Wire
Sensor Assy RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
D
C
ESR
-
S17
VUPR SSR-
(b)
B
A18
ESR
(c)
SSR+
VUPR
SST
SSR+
H01015
C91384
C91385 C82599
SSR-
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the side airbag sensor assy RH.
Using SST, connect S17-4 (VUPR) and S17-1 (ESR),
and connect S17-3 (SSR+) and S17-2 (SSR-) of connector ”C”.
SST 09843-18040
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-17 (VUPR) A18-15 (ESR)
Always
Below 1 Ω
A18-16 (SSR+) A18-13 (SSR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
H42483
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(TO GROUND)
Floor Wire
D
C
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy RH
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
B
A18
ESR
VUPR
H01015
C83438
Disconnect the SST from connector ”C”.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-17 (VUPR) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A18-15 (ESR) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A18-16 (SSR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A18-13 (SSR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
SSR+
SSR-
H42229
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1514
05-1325
DIAGNOSTICS
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(TO B+)
Floor Wire
D
C
(a)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
(b)
(c)
B
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy RH
A18
ESR
VUPR
H01015
C83438
-
SSR+
SSR-
H42229
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-17 (VUPR) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A18-15 (ESR) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A18-16 (SSR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A18-13 (SSR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(SHORT)
Floor Wire
D
C
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy RH
(c)
B
A18
ESR
VUPR
H01015
C83438
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-17 (VUPR) A18-15 (ESR)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A18-16 (SSR+) A18-13 (SSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
SSR+
SSR-
H42229
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1515
05-1326
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK SIDE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY RH
Side
Airbag
Sensor
Assy LH
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
DTC B1140/32
(e)
(f)
(g)
DLC3
DTC B1141/33
CG
(h)
TC
H01012
H10600 H01065
H01066
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Interchange the side airbag sensor assy RH with LH and
connect the connectors to them.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
Result:
H42115
NG: A
DTC B1140/32 is output.
NG: B
DTC B1141/33 is output.
DTC B1140/32 and B1141/33 are not
output.
OK
NG:A
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
NG:B
REPLACE SIDE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 60-57 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1516
05-1327
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVL-01
B1141/33 SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY (LH)
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side airbag sensor assy LH consists of the safing sensor, diagnosis circuit and lateral deceleration sensor, etc.
It receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor, judges whether or not the SRS must be activated,
and detects diagnosis system malfunction.
DTC B1141/33 is recorded when occurrence of a malfunction in the side airbag sensor assy LH is detected.
DTC No.
B1141/33
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Side airbag sensor assy LH
Floor wire No.2
Airbag sensor assy center
Side airbag sensor assy LH malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
S16
Side Airbag Sensor Assy LH
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
1
B
(*1)
4
W
ESL
VUPL
18
A16 ESL
16
A16 VUPL
(*1)
3
SSL+
17
A16 SSL+
G
(*1)
2
SSL-
20
A16 SSL-
R
(*1)
*1: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
H43054
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1517
05-1328
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a)
Side
Airbag
Sensor
Assy LH
DLC3
(b)
(c)
(d)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(e)
DTC B1141/33
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1141/33 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1141/33 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
CG
H01007
H10600 H01066
TC
H40445
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER CONNECTOR
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait at least for 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the airbag sensor assy center and the side airbag
sensor assy LH.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1518
05-1329
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(OPEN)
(a)
Floor Wire No.2
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D
C
B
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy LH
S16
(b)
(c)
A16
ESL VUPL SSL- SSL+
VUPL
SST
-
SST
SSL+
SSL-
H01010 C91385
C91384 C82600
ESL
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the side airbag sensor assy LH.
Using SST, connect S16-4 (VUPL) and S16-1 (ESL),
and connect S16-3 (SSL+) and S16-2 (SSL-) of connector ”C”.
SST 09843 - 18040
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-16 (VUPL) A16-18 (ESL)
Always
Below 1 Ω
A16-17 (SSL+) A16-20 (SSL-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
H43148
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(TO GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
D
C
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy LH
B
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
A16
VUPL
SSLH01010
C83441
Disconnect the SST from connector ”C”
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-16 (VUPL) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A16-18 (ESL) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A16-17 (SSL+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A16-20 (SSL-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
SSL+
ESL
H42231
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1519
05-1330
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(TO B+)
(a)
Floor Wire No.2
D
C
B
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy LH
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(b)
(c)
A16
VUPL
SSL-
SSL+
ESL
H01010
C83441
H42231
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-16 (VUPL) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A16-18 (ESL) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A16-17 (SSL+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A16-20 (SSL-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(SHORT)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
D
C
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy LH
B
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
A16
VUPL
SSLH01010
C83441
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-16 (VUPL) A16-18 (ESL)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A16-17 (SSL+) A16-20 (SSL-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
SSL+
ESL
H42231
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1520
05-1331
DIAGNOSTICS
7
DLC3
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
DTC B1140/32
(e)
(f)
(g)
DTC B1141/33
H01007
H10600
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
Side
Airbag
Sensor
Assy RH
CG
-
TC
H01065
H01066
(h)
Connect the airbag sensor assy center connector.
Interchange the side airbag sensor assy RH with LH and
connect the connectors to them.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait at for
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTC (see page 05-1215 ).
Result:
H42116
NG: A
DTC B1140/32 is output.
NG: B
DTC B1141/33 is output.
DTC B1140/32 and B1141/33 are not
output.
OK
NG:A
REPLACE SIDE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY LH
(SEE PAGE 60-57 )
NG:B
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1521
05-1332
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVN-01
B1148/36 FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (RH)
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The airbag front RH sensor circuit consists of the diagnostic circuit and the frontal deceleration sensor, etc.
If the airbag sensor assy center receives signals from the frontal deceleration sensor, it judges whether or
not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1148/36 is recorded when a malfunction in the airbag front RH sensor is detected.
DTC No.
B1148/36
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in front airbag sensor RH wire harness (to
B+)
Short circuit in front airbag sensor RH wire harness (to
ground)
Open circuit in +SR wire harness or -SL wire harness of
front airbag sensor RH
Airbag front RH sensor malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Airbag front RH sensor
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
Engine room main wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
A9
Airbag Front RH Sensor
+SR
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
B-W
3
IK1
W
9
A17 +SR
BR-W
4
IK1
B
20
A17 -SR
2
-SR
1
H02750
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1522
05-1333
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a)
Airbag
Front
RH
Sensor
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
DTC B1148/36
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1148/36 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1148/36 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
CG
TC
H02757
H10600 H16834
H42117
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the airbag sensor assy center and the airbag front
RH sensor.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1523
05-1334
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (RH) CIRCUIT (OPEN)
(a)
Airbag
Front F
RH Sensor
-SR
A9
E
DC
B
+SR
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
A17
+SR
-SR
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the airbag front RH sensor.
(b) Using a service wire, connect A9-2 (+SR) and A9-1 (SR) of connector ”E”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Service Wire
H03353
H08016 C81408
H41800
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-9 (+SR) A17-20 (-SR)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Go to step 8
OK
4
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (RH) CIRCUIT (TO B+)
Airbag
Front F
RH Sensor
E
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
A17
+SR
-SR
H03355
C81408
H42510
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-9 (+SR) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A17-20 (-SR) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
Go to step 9
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1524
05-1335
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (RH) CIRCUIT (TO GROUND)
Airbag
Front F
RH Sensor
E
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(a)
(b)
(c)
A17
+SR
-SR
H03355
C81408
H42510
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-9 (+SR) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A17-20 (-SR) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
Go to step 10
OK
6
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (RH) CIRCUIT (SHORT)
(a)
Airbag
Front F
RH Sensor
E
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-9 (+SR) A17-20 (-SR)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A17
+SR
-SR
H03355
C81408
H42510
NG
Go to step 11
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1525
05-1336
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG FRONT RH SENSOR
Airbag
Sensor
Front LH
DC
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
DTC B1148/36
(e)
(f)
(g)
DLC3
DTC B1149/37
CG
(h)
TC
H02757
H10600 H16834
H16835
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Interchange the airbag front RH sensor with the airbag
sensor front LH and connect the connectors to them.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
Result:
H42118
NG: A
DTC B1149/37 is output.
NG: B
DTC B1148/36 is output.
DTC B1148/36 and B1149/37 are not
output.
OK
NG:A
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR FRONT RH
(SEE PAGE 60-55 )
NG:B
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1526
05-1337
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE(OPEN)
Engine Room
Main Wire
Airbag
Front
RH
Sensor
(a)
Cowl Wire
F
E
D C
A9
+SR
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
IK1
-SR
Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from the
cowl wire.
HINT:
Connector ”E” has already been inserted into the service wire.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
IK1-3 (+SR) IK1-4 (-SR)
Always
Below 1 Ω
+SR
-SR
H03352
NG
Service Wire
H43424
C81305
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
9
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE(TO B+)
Engine Room
Main Wire
Airbag
Front
F
RH
Sensor
E
Cowl Wire
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
IK1
(e)
(f)
-SR
H03354
C81305
+SR
H43447
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from the
cowl wire.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
IK1-3 (+SR) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
IK1-4 (-SR) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1527
05-1338
DIAGNOSTICS
10
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE(TO GROUND)
Engine Room
Main Wire
Airbag
Front
F
RH
Sensor
E
(a)
Cowl Wire
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(b)
IK1
Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from the
cowl wire.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
IK1-3 (+SR) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
IK1-4 (-SR) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
+SR
-SR
H03354
C81305
H43447
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
11
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE(SHORT)
Engine Room
Main Wire
Airbag
Front
F
RH
Sensor
E
(a)
Cowl Wire
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
IK1
-SR
H03354
C81305
(b)
Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from the
cowl wire.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
IK1-3 (+SR) IK1-4 (-SR)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
+SR
H43447
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1528
05-1339
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVO-02
B1149/37 FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (LH)
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The airbag sensor front LH circuit consists of the diagnostic circuit and the frontal deceleration sensor, etc.
If the airbag sensor assy center receives signals from the frontal deceleration sensor, it judges whether or
not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1149/37 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the airbag sensor front LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
B1149/37
Short circuit in front airbag sensor LH wire harness (to B+)
Short circuit in front airbag sensor LH wire harness (to
ground)
Open circuit in +SL wire harness or -SL wire harness of
front airbag sensor LH
Airbag sensor front LH malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Airbag sensor front LH
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
Engine room main wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
A8
Airbag Sensor Front LH
+SL
-SL
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
W-R
2
IK1
G
15
A17 +SL
BR
1
IK1
R
26
A17 -SL
2
1
H02750
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1529
05-1340
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a)
Airbag
Sensor
Front LH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
CG
H02757
H10600
DTC B1149/37
HINT:
Codes other than code B1149/37 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
TC
H16835
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1149/37 is not output.
H42119
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connector is properly connected to the airbag sensor assy center and the airbag sensor
front LH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1530
05-1341
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (LH) CIRCUIT (OPEN)
(a)
F
E
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
-SL
A8
+SL
+SL
Service Wire
A17
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the airbag sensor front LH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect A8-2 (+SL) and A8-1 (-SL)
of connector ”E”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
-SL
H03353
H08016 C81408
H41800
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-15 (+SL) A17-26 (-SL)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Go to step 8
OK
4
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (LH) CIRCUIT (TO B+)
F
E
DC
B
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
+SL
H03355
C81408
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
A17
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-15 (+SL) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A17-26 (-SL) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
-SL
H42510
NG
Go to step 9
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1531
05-1342
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (LH) CIRCUIT (TO GROUND)
F
A
E
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(a)
(b)
(c)
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
+SL
A17
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-15 (+SL) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A17-26 (-SL) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
-SL
H03355
C81408
H42510
NG
Go to step 10
OK
6
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (LH) CIRCUIT (SHORT)
(a)
F
A
E
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
+SL
H03355
C81408
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-15 (+SL) A17-26 (-SL)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A17
-SL
H42510
NG
Go to step 11
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1532
05-1343
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR FRONT LH
Airbag
Front
RH Sensor
DC
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
DTC B1148/36
(e)
(f)
(g)
DLC3
DTC B1149/37
CG
(h)
TC
H02757
H10600 H16834
H16835
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Interchange the airbag front sensor RH with the airbag
sensor front LH and connect the connectors to them.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
Result:
H42120
NG: A
DTC B1149/37 is output.
NG: B
DTC B1148/36 is output.
DTC B1148/36 and B1149/37 are not
output.
OK
NG:A
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
NG:B
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR FRONT LH
(SEE PAGE 60-55 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1533
05-1344
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE(OPEN)
Engine Room
Main Wire
F
E
D C
B
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
-SL
(a)
Cowl Wire
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
IK1
A8
H03352
C81305
HINT:
Connector ”E” has already been inserted into the service wire.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
+SL
+SL
-SL
Service Wire
H43424
Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from the
cowl wire.
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
IK1-1 (-SL) IK1-2 (+SL)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
9
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE(TO B+)
Engine Room
Main Wire
Cowl Wire
F
E
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
IK1
(e)
(f)
-SL
H03354
C81305
+SL
H43447
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from the
cowl wire.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
IK1-1 (-SL) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
IK1-2 (+SL) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1534
05-1345
DIAGNOSTICS
10
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE(TO GROUND)
Engine Room
Main Wire
F
E
(a)
Cowl Wire
D C
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(b)
IK1
-SL
+SL
H03354
C81305
H43447
Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from the
cowl wire.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
IK1-1 (-SL) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
IK1-2 (+SL) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
11
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE(SHORT)
Engine Room
Main Wire
F
E
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
-SL
H03354
C81305
(a)
Cowl Wire
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
IK1
(b)
Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from the
cowl wire.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
IK1-1 (-SL) IK1-2 (+SL)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
+SL
H43447
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1535
05-1346
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVP-03
B1150/23 OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The occupant classification system circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the occupant classification system.
DTC B1150/23 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification system circuit.
DTC No.
B1150/23
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Floor wire
Front seat wire RH
Occupant classification ECU
Airbag sensor assy center
Occupant classification system malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
Occupant Classification ECU
8
FSR+ O6
4
FSR- O6
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
1
W
B
W
BL1
4
BL1
B
1
3
A18 A18 FSR+
(*2) (*1)
2
10
A18 A18 FSR(*2) (*1)
*1: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/o Curtain Shield Airbag
H43055
H44105
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1536
05-1347
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
CHECK DTC(OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at least 10 seconds.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs of the occupant classification ECU (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC is not output.
NG
GO TO INSPECTION PROCEDURE OF DTC
OUTPUT
OK
2
CHECK DTC (AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER)
(a)
Occupant
Classification ECU
(b)
(c)
(d)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(e)
DTC B1150/23
DLC3
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1150/23 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1150/23 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
CG TC
H44090 H02757
H10600 H44098
H44535
NG
Go to step 3
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
3
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the airbag sensor assy center and the occupant
classification ECU.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1537
05-1348
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU CIRCUIT(OPEN)
(a)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
F
E
DC
B
FSR-
FSR+
FSR+
FSRO6
FSR+
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the occupant classification ECU.
(b) Using a service wire, connect O6-8 (FSR+) and O6-4
(FSR-) of connector ”E”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag:
FSRA18 (*2)
A18 (*1)
Condition
Specified condition
A18-3 (FSR+) A18-10 (FSR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
w/o Side and curtain shield airbag:
Service Wire
H44130 H44536
H41715 H43694
Tester connection
*1: w/ Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/o Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
H44681
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-1 (FSR+) A18-2 (FSR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Go to step 8
OK
5
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU CIRCUIT (SHORT)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
F
E
FSR-
DC
B
FSRFSR+
FSR+
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-3 (FSR+) A18-10 (FSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
w/o Side and curtain shield airbag:
A18
w/o Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
H41715 H44130
A18
w/ Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
H44536
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-1 (FSR+) A18-2 (FSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
Go to step 9
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1538
05-1349
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU CIRCUIT (TO B+)
(a)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
F
E
DC
B
FSRFSR+
FSR+
FSR-
A18
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag:
A18
w/o Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
Condition
Specified condition
A18-3 (FSR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A18-10 (FSR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
w/o Side and curtain shield airbag:
w/ Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
H44536
H41715 H44130
Tester connection
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-1 (FSR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A18-2 (FSR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
Go to step 10
OK
7
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU CIRCUIT (TO GROUND)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
F
E
FSR-
DC
FSRFSR+
FSR+
A18
w/o Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
H41715 H44130
B
A18
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-3 (FSR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A18-10 (FSR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
w/o Side and curtain shield airbag:
w/ Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
H44536
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-1 (FSR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A18-2 (FSR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
Go to step 11
OK
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 60-53 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1539
05-1350
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH(OPEN)
Occupant
Floor Wire
Classification
Front Seat
ECU
Wire RH
F
E
D C
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
B
Disconnect the front seat wire RH connector from the floor
wire.
HINT:
Connector ”E” has already been inserted into the service wire.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
BL1
O6
FSR+
(a)
FSR-
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BL1-1 (FSR+) BL1-4 (FSR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
FSR+
FSRH43129
H03354
H43116
Service Wire
H44538
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
9
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH(SHORT)
Occupant
Floor Wire
Classification Front Seat
Airbag
Wire RH
ECU
Sensor
Assy
F
A Center
E
D C B
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the front seat wire RH connector from the floor
wire.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BL1-1 (FSR+) BL1-4 (FSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
BL1
FSR+
FSRH03354
H43116
H43129
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1540
05-1351
DIAGNOSTICS
10
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH(TO B+)
Occupant
Floor Wire
Classification Front Seat
Airbag
Wire RH
ECU
Sensor
Assy
F
A Center
E
D C B
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
BL1
FSR+
FSRH03354
H43116
H43129
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from battery,
and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the front seat wire RH connector from the floor
wire.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BL1-1 (FSR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
BL1-4 (FSR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
11
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH(TO GROUND)
Occupant
Floor Wire
Classification Front Seat
Airbag
Wire RH
ECU
Sensor
Assy
F
A Center
E
D C B
BL1
FSR+
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the front seat wire RH connector from the floor
wire.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BL1-1 (FSR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
BL1-4 (FSR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
FSRH03354
H43116
H43129
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1541
05-1352
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVQ-02
B1152/28 PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR
LIGHT CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator light circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the telltale
lamp assy (passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator).
This circuit indicates the operation condition of the front passenger airbag assy and the front seat airbag assy
RH and passenger side seat belt pretensioner.
DTC B1152/28 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator light
circuit.
DTC No.
B1152/28
DTC Detecting Condition
When the airbag sensor assy center receives a line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or B+ short
signal in the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator light circuit for 2 seconds.
Telltale lamp assy malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Trouble Area
Telltale lamp (Passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1542
05-1353
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
T15
Telltale Light assembly
Airbag Sensor
Assy Center
Instrument Panel J/B
AIRBAG ON
PAON
14
IL1
W
7
P-AB
11
1E
5
1K
Y
L
2
8
1L
2
1L
G
B
25
A17 PAON
1
A17 P-AB
AIRBAG OFF
Center J/B
SW1 W-B
5
IG+
R
4
10
3F
13
3F
6
3F
10
3A
GR
F7
F/L Block
W
B
1
ALT
2
W-B
Instrument Panel J/B
IG1
10
7 I15 Ignition SW
G
1K
1C
4 IG1 AM1 2
1
1A
AM1
1
2
6
1C
W
FL MAIN
Battery
IB
H44547
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1543
05-1354
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR LIGHT OPERATION
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Check the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator light operation.
HINT:
Refer to the normal condition of the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator light (see page 05-1207 ).
A
B
4 sec.
2 sec.
4 sec.
2 sec.
C
ON
Ignition Switch
OFF
ON
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator Light
(”ON”)
OFF
Passenger Airbag
ON
ON/OFF Indicator Light
(”OFF”)
OFF
ON/OFF condition depends on the
front passenger detection results.
H43700
Result:
A:
During period ”A” in the illustration, even if both the ”ON” and ”OFF” passenger airbag ON/OFF
indicator lights normally come on, both of them do not go off during period ”B”.
During periods ”A” and ”B” in the illustration, even if both the ”ON” and ”OFF” passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator lights normally come on, both of them come on during period ”C”.
B:
During period ”A”, neither the ”ON” nor ”OFF” passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator lights come
on, or one of them does not come on.
During period ”C”, even if the front passenger seat is occupied, neither the ”ON” nor ”OFF”
passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator lights come on.
B
Go to step 6
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1544
05-1355
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK TELLTALE LAMP ASSY (PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR
LIGHT)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
H44095
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connector from the telltale lamp assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Check the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator light operation.
OK:
The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator light (”ON”
and ”OFF”) do not come on.
NG
REPLACE TELLTALE LAMP ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-10 )
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TO GROUND)
(a)
Telltale
Lamp D
Assy
A17
C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-1 (P-AB) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A17-25 (PAON) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
P-AB
PAON
H01015 H43468
G27651 H40065
H44539
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1545
05-1356
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SHORT)
(a)
Telltale
Lamp D
Assy
C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
A17
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-1 (P-AB) A17-25 (PAON)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
P-AB
PAON
H01015 H43468
G27651 H40065
NG
H44539
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
OK
5
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Telltale
Lamp
Assy
(a)
(b)
(c)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(d)
DTC B1152/28
DLC3
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
CG
H43087
H01012 H43467
H10600 H01069
TC
H44541
Connect the connectors to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the connector to the clock assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1152/28 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1152/28 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1546
05-1357
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
WIRE HARNESS (SOURCE VOLTAGE)
(a)
T15
(b)
(c)
IG+
SW1
H44540
I40606
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage and resistance according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
T15-4 (IG+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
T15-5 (SW1) Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE TELLTALE LAMP ASSY OR WIRE
HARNESS (TELLTALE LAMP ASSY - BATTERY)
OR BATTERY
OK
7
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (OPEN)
Telltale
Lamp D
Assy
C
B
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
A Assy
Center
T15
A17
P-AB
P-AB
PAON
H44540
H01015 H43469
H43625 G27651
PAON
Service Wire
H44542
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect T15-2 (P-AB) and T15-7
(PAON) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of
connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-1 (P-AB) A17-25 (PAON)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1547
05-1358
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TO B+)
(a)
(b)
Telltale
Lamp D
Assy
A17
C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
P-AB
PAON
H01015 H43468
G27651 H40065
H44539
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-25 (PAON) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A17-1 (P-AB) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
OK
9
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
(c)
A17
E2
E1
H40065
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-27 (E1) Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
A17-28 (E2) Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1548
05-1359
DIAGNOSTICS
10
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Telltale
Lamp
Assy
(a)
(b)
(c)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(d)
DTC B1152/28
DLC3
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
CG
H43087
H01012 H43467
H10600 H01069
TC
H44541
Connect the connectors to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the connector to the clock assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1152/28 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1152/28 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1549
05-1360
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVT-02
B1153/25 SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The seat position airbag sensor circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the seat position airbag
sensor.
DTC B1153/25 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the seat position airbag sensor circuit.
DTC No.
B1153/25
DTC Detecting Condition
Open circuit in LSP+ wire harness or LSP- wire harness
of seat position airbag sensor
Short circuit in seat position airbag sensor wire harness
(to ground)
Short circuit in seat position airbag sensor wire harness
(to B+)
Seat position airbag sensor malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Trouble Area
Seat position airbag sensor
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
B19
Seat Position Airbag Sensor (Driver’s Side)
VS
GND
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
3
4
A16 A16 LSP+
(*2) (*1)
W
2
8
3
A16 A16 LSP(*2) (*1)
B
4
*1: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/o Curtain Shield Airbag
H43119
H44103
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1550
05-1361
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a)
Seat
Position
Airbag
Sensor
DLC3
CG
(b)
(c)
(d)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(e)
DTC B1153/25
HINT:
Codes other than code B1153/25 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
TC
H01007
H10600 C91522
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1153/25 is not output.
H42468
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the airbag sensor assy center and the seat position airbag sensor.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1551
05-1362
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(OPEN)
(a)
Seat
Position
Airbag
Sensor
Floor Wire No.2
D
C
B
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
A16
*2
B19
4
2
A16 *1
LSP+
LSP+
LSPLSP-
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the seat position airbag sensor.
(b) Using a service wire, connect B19-2 and B19-4 of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag:
Service Wire
*1: w/ Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/o Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
H42467
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-4 (LSP+) A16-3 (LSP-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
w/o Side and curtain shield airbag:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-3 (LSP+) A16-8 (LSP-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(TO B+)
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag:
Floor Wire No.2
D
C
B
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
A16 *2
LSP+
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
LSP-
LSP+
A16
*1
LSP-
*1: w/ Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/o Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
H42459
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-4 (LSP+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A16-3 (LSP-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
w/o Side and curtain shield airbag:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-3 (LSP+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A16-8 (LSP-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1552
05-1363
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(TO GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag:
Floor Wire No.2
D
C
B
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
LSP-
A16 *2
LSP+
A16
LSP+
*1
LSP-
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-4 (LSP+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A16-3 (LSP-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
w/o Side and curtain shield airbag:
*1: w/ Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/o Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
H42459
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-3 (LSP+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A16-8 (LSP-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(SHORT)
(a)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag:
Floor Wire No.2
D
C
B
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
A16 *2
LSP+
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
LSP-
LSP+
A16
Condition
Specified condition
A16-4 (LSP+) A16-3 (LSP-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
w/o Side and curtain shield airbag:
*1
LSP-
*1: w/ Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/o Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
Tester connection
H42459
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-3 (LSP+) A16-8 (LSP-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1553
05-1364
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
(a)
Seat
Position
Airbag
Sensor
DLC3
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
DTC B1153/25
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
CG
H01007
H10600 C91522
TC
H42468
Connect the connectors to the seat position airbag sensor
and the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1153/25 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1153/25 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1554
05-1365
DIAGNOSTICS
8
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
REPLACE SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the seat position airbag sensor (see page 60-61 ).
9
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
Seat
Position
Airbag
Sensor
DLC3
CG
H01007
H10600 C91522
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DTC B1153/25
TC
H42468
(f)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1153/25 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1153/25 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1555
05-1366
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVU-01
B1154/38 AIRBAG SENSOR REAR (RH)
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The airbag sensor rear RH consists of the safing sensor, the diagnostic circuit and the lateral deceleration
sensor, etc.
If the airbag sensor assy center receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor, it judges whether or
not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1154/38 is recorded when a malfunction in the airbag sensor rear RH is detected.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
B1154/38
Short circuit in airbag sensor rear RH wire harness (to
ground)
Short circuit in airbag sensor rear RH wire harness (to B+)
Open circuit in airbag sensor rear RH wire harness
Short circuit in airbag sensor rear RH wire harness
Airbag sensor rear RH malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Airbag sensor rear RH
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
S33
Airbag Sensor Rear RH
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
ESCR 1
VUCR
CSR-
CSR+
20
A18 ESCR
B
(*1)
4
W
(*1)
2
G
(*1)
3
R
(*1)
19
A18 VUCR
4
A18 CSR-
18
A18 CSR+
*1 w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
H43054
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1556
05-1367
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a)
Airbag
Sensor
Rear RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
CG
DTC B1154/38
HINT:
Codes other than code B1154/38 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
TC
H01012
H10600 C92968
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1154/38 is not output.
H42125
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the airbag sensor assy center and the airbag
sensor rear RH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1557
05-1368
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(OPEN)
(a)
Airbag Sensor Floor Wire
Rear RH
D
A
C
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(b)
A18
(c)
B
S33
ESCR VUCR
CSR- CSR+
CSRESCR
VUCR
CSR+
SST
H01015
C91384
C91385 C82599
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the airbag sensor rear assy RH.
Using SST, connect S33-4 (VUCR) to S33-1 (ESCR),
and connect S33-3 (CSR+) to S33-2 (CSR-) of connector ”C”.
SST 09843-18040
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-19 (VUCR) A18-20 (ESCR)
Always
Below 1 Ω
A18-18 (CSR+) A18-4 (CSR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
H42483
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(TO B+)
Floor Wire
B
D
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
(c)
(d)
C
Airbag Sensor
Rear RH
CSRESCR
A18
VUCR
CSR+
H01015
C82599
H42484
Disconnect the SST from connector ”C”.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-19 (VUCR) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A18-20 (ESCR) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A18-18 (CSR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A18-4 (CSR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1558
05-1369
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(TO GROUND)
Floor Wire
B
D
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
(c)
C
Airbag Sensor
Rear RH
CSRESCR
A18
VUCR
CSR+
H01015
C82599
H42484
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-19 (VUCR) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A18-20 (ESCR) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A18-18 (CSR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A18-4 (CSR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(SHORT)
Floor Wire
B
D
(a)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
C
Airbag Sensor
Rear RH
CSRESCR
A18
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-19 (VUCR) A18-20 (ESCR)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A18-18 (CSR+) A18-4 (CSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
VUCR
CSR+
H01015
C82599
H42484
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1559
05-1370
DIAGNOSTICS
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR REAR RH
Airbag
Sensor
Rear LH
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
DTC B1154/38
CG
-
TC
H01012
H10600 C92968
C92969
DTC B1155/39
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Interchange the airbag sensor rear LH with RH and connect the connectors to them.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
Result:
H42126
NG: A
DTC B1154/38 is output.
NG: B
DTC B1155/39 is output.
DTC B1154/38 and B1155/39 are not
output.
OK
NG:A
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
NG:B
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR REAR RH
(SEE PAGE 60-59 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1560
05-1371
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVV-01
B1155/39 AIRBAG SENSOR REAR (LH)
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The airbag sensor rear LH consists of the safing sensor, the diagnostic circuit and the lateral deceleration
sensor, etc.
If the airbag sensor assy center receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor, it judges whether or
not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1155/39 is recorded when a malfunction in the airbag sensor rear LH is detected.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
B1155/39
Short circuit in airbag sensor rear LH wire harness (to
ground)
Short circuit in airbag sensor rear LH wire harness (to B+)
Open circuit in airbag sensor rear LH wire harness
Short circuit in airbag sensor rear LH wire harness
Airbag sensor rear LH malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Airbag sensor rear LH
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
S32
Airbag Sensor Rear LH
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
ESCL 1
VUCL
CSL-
CSL+
13
A16 ESCL
B
(*1)
4
W
(*1)
2
G
(*1)
3
R
(*1)
14
A16 VUCL
1
A16 CSL-
15
A16 CSL+
*1 w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
H43054
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1561
05-1372
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a)
Airbag
Sensor
Rear LH
(b)
(c)
(d)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(e)
DLC3
DTC B1155/39
CG
HINT:
Codes other than code B1155/39 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
TC
H01007
H10600 C92969
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1155/39 is not output.
H42127
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the airbag sensor assy center and the airbag
sensor rear LH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1562
05-1373
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(OPEN)
(a)
Floor Wire No.2
D
C
B
Airbag Sensor
Rear LH
S32
ESCL VUCL CSL- CSL+
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(b)
(c)
A16
CSLESCL
VUCL
CSL+
SST
SST
H01010 C91385
C91384 C82600
H43148
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the airbag sensor rear assy LH.
Using SST, connect S32-1 (VUCL) to S32-4 (ESCL), and
connect S32-3 (CSL+) to S32-2 (CSL-) of connector ”C”.
SST 09843-18040
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-14 (VUCL) A16-13 (ESCL)
Always
Below 1 Ω
A16-15 (CSL+) A16-1 (CSL-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(TO B+)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
D
C
Airbag Sensor
Rear LH
D
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
A16
H01010
C82600
Disconnect the SST from connector ”C”.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
CSL-
A16-14 (VUCL) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
ESCL
A16-13 (ESCL) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A16-15 (CSL+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A16-1 (CSL-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
VUCL
CSL+
H42486
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1563
05-1374
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(TO GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
D
C
B
Airbag Sensor
Rear LH
A16
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
CSLESCL
VUCL
CSL+
H01010
C82600
H42486
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-14 (VUCL) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A16-13 (ESCL) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A16-15 (CSL+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A16-1 (CSL-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(SHORT)
(a)
Floor Wire No.2
D
C
Airbag Sensor
Rear LH
A16
B
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A16-14 (VUCL) A16-13 (ESCL)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A16-15 (CSL+) A16-1 (CSL-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
CSLESCL
H01010
C82600
VUCL
CSL+
H42486
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1564
05-1375
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR REAR LH
Airbag
Sensor
Rear RH
DLC3
CG
TC
H01007
H10600 C92968
C92969
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
DTC B1154/38
DTC B1155/39
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Interchange the airbag sensor rear LH with RH and connect the connectors to them.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
Result:
H42128
NG: A
DTC B1154/38 is output.
NG: B
DTC B1155/39 is output.
DTC B1154/38 and B1155/39 are not
output.
OK
NG:A
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR REAR LH
(SEE PAGE 60-59 )
NG:B
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1565
05-1376
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVW-02
B1160/83 SHORT IN CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB (RH)
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib RH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the curtain shield airbag
assy RH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1160/83 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the curtain shield squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
B1160/83
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between ICR+ wire harness and ICR- wire
harness of curtain shield squib RH
Curtain shield squib RH malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Curtain shield airbag assy RH (Curtain shield squib RH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Roof wire No.2 (w/ Rear seat entertainment system)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
Y
(*2 *3)
C19
Curtain Shield Squib RH
1
Y
(*1 *3)
2
Y-B
(*1 *3)
2
BK2
Y
(*1 *3)
1
BK2
Y-B
(*1 *3)
8
A18 ICR+
7
A18 ICR-
Y-B
(*2 *3)
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
*2: w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
*3: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
*4: w/o Curtain Shield Airbag
H43058
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1566
05-1377
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK VEHICLE CONDITION
Check whether or not the vehicle is equipped with the rear seat entertainment system.
Result:
A: w/o Rear seat entertainment system
B: w/ Rear seat entertainment system
B
Go to step 6
A
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
CHECK CONNECTOR
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least for 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the curtain shield airbag assy RH.
Check that the floor wire connector (on the curtain shield airbag assy RH side) is not damaged.
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, or the claw of the lock is not deformed or damaged.
B
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
A
3
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a)
Floor Wire
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
D C
ICR+
H41465
B
(b)
(c)
C19
ICR-
H43068
Disconnect the connector from the airbag sensor assy
center.
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”B” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C19-1 (ICR+) C19-2 (ICR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1567
05-1378
DIAGNOSTICS
4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
D C
DLC3
DTC B1160/83
(g)
CG
-
TC
H01020
H10600 H11644
H40956
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1160/83 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1160/83 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1568
05-1379
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
DC
DLC3
(e)
DTC B1160/83
(f)
(g)
(h)
TC
CG
H01021
H10600 H11644
H40931
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Cconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1160/83 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1160/83 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 60-38 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1569
05-1380
DIAGNOSTICS
6
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CONNECTOR
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least for 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the curtain shield airbag assy RH.
Check that the roof wire No.2 connector (on the curtain shield airbag assy RH side) is not damaged.
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, or the claw of the lock is not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ROOF WIRE NO.2
OK
7
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB (RH) CIRCUIT
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
F
E
ICR+
DC
B
ICR-
(c)
Disconnect the connector from the airbag sensor assy
center.
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”B” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C19-1 (ICR+) C19-2 (ICR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
C19
H42818
H43068
H43091
NG
Go to step 10
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1570
05-1381
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
F E
DLC3
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
DC
DTC B1160/83
(g)
CG
TC
H43101
H10600 H11644
H43124
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1160/83 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1160/83 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1571
05-1382
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
FE
(c)
(d)
DC
(e)
DLC3
DTC B1160/83
(f)
(g)
(h)
CG
TC
H42819
H40931
H43092
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1160/83 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1160/83 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 60-38 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1572
05-1383
DIAGNOSTICS
10
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE
(a)
Roof Wire No.2
Curtain
Shield
Squib RH
F E
Floor Wire
D C
HINT:
The activation prevention mechanism of connector ”B” has already been released.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
B
BK2
ICR-
ICR+
H42820
H42497
Disconnect the floor wire connector from the roof wire
No.2.
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BK2-2 (ICR+) BK2-1 (ICR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
H42847
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
11
CHECK ROOF WIRE NO.2
(a)
Roof Wire No.2
Curtain
Floor Wire
Shield
Squib RH
A
F E
ICR-
H42821
C89244
D C
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(b)
B
C19
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”D” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C19-1 (ICR+) C19-2 (ICR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
ICR+
H43067
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ROOF WIRE NO.2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1573
05-1384
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVX-01
B1161/84 OPEN IN CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB (RH)
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib RH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the curtain shield airbag
assy RH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1161/84 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the curtain shield squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
B1161/84
Open circuit in ICR+ wire harness or ICR- wire harness of
curtain shield squib RH
Curtain shield squib RH malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Curtain shield airbag assy RH (Curtain shield squib RH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Roof wire No.2 (w/ Rear seat entertainment system)
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1376 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK VEHICLE CONDITION
Check whether or not the vehicle is equipped with the rear seat entertainment system.
Result:
A: w/o Rear seat entertainment system
B: w/ Rear seat entertainment system
B
Go to step 5
A
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
D C
(c)
(d)
B
C19
ICR+
H41465
ICR-
H43068
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the curtain shield airbag assy RH.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C19-1 (ICR+) C19-2 (ICR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1574
05-1385
DIAGNOSTICS
3
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
C
D
C19
ICR+
ICR-
Service Wire
DLC3
H01020
C89252
H11645
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Floor Wire
CG
-
DTC B1161/84
TC
H10600
H42129
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect C19-1 (ICR+) and C19-2
(ICR-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1161/84 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1161/84 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1575
05-1386
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DC
DLC3
CG
H01021
H10600
DTC B1161/84
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H11645
(f)
H40933
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1161/84 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1161/84 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 60-38 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1576
05-1387
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB (RH) CIRCUIT
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
F E
DC
ICR+
B
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
(c)
(d)
ICRC19
H42818
H43068
H43091
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center assy and the curtain shield airbag assy RH.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C19-1 (ICR+) C19-2 (ICR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
F E DC
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
C19
ICR+
ICR-
Service Wire
DLC3
CG
H43102
C89252
H11645
DTC B1161/84
TC
H10600
H43125
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect C19-1 (ICR+) and C19-2
(ICR-) of connector ”E”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Clear the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1161/84 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1161/84 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1577
05-1388
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
FE
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DC
DLC3
DTC B1161/84
CG
H42819
H40933
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H43093
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1161/84 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1161/84 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 60-38 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1578
05-1389
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE
(a)
Roof Wire No.2
Curtain
Floor Wire
Shield
Squib RH
F E
D C
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
(b)
B
Disconnect the floor wire connector from the roof wire
No.2.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BK2-2 (ICR+) BK2-1 (ICR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
BK2
ICR-
ICR+
H42820
H42497
H42847
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
9
CHECK ROOF WIRE NO.2
Roof Wire No.2
Curtain
Floor Wire
Shield
Squib RH
F E
D C
(a)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C19-1 (ICR+) C19-2 (ICR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
B
C19
ICR+
H42821
C89244
ICR-
H43067
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ROOF WIRE NO.2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1579
05-1390
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVY-01
B1162/81 SHORT IN CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB (RH)
CIRCUIT (TO GROUND)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib RH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the curtain shield airbag
assy RH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1162/81 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the curtain shield squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in curtain shield squib RH wire harness (to
ground)
Curtain shield squib RH malfunction
Airbag sensor assy malfunction
B1162/81
Curtain shield airbag assy RH (Curtain shield squib RH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Roof wire No.2 (w/ Rear seat entertainment system)
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1376 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK VEHICLE CONDITION
Check whether or not the vehicle is equipped with the rear seat entertainment system.
Result:
A: w/o Rear seat entertainment system
B: w/ Rear seat entertainment system
B
Go to step 5
A
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
D C
(c)
(d)
B
C19
ICR+
H41465
ICR-
H43068
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the curtain shield airbag assy RH.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C19-1 (ICR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
C19-2 (ICR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1580
05-1391
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Floor Wire
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
C
D
C19
ICR+
ICR-
Service Wire
DLC3
CG
H01020
C89252
H10600
DTC B1162/81
TC
H11642
H42130
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect C19-1 (ICR+) and C19-2
(ICR-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1162/81 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1162/81 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1581
05-1392
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DC
DLC3
CG
DTC B1162/81
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H01021
H10600
H11642
(f)
H40938
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1162/81 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1162/81 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 60-38 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1582
05-1393
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB (RH) CIRCUIT
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
F E
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
B
(c)
(d)
ICR-
ICR+
C19
H42818
H43068
H43091
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the curtain shield airbag assy RH.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C19-1 (ICR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
C19-2 (ICR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
F E
(a)
(b)
DC
ICR+
C19
ICR-
Service Wire
DLC3
CG
H43102
C89252
H10600
DTC B1162/81
TC
H11642
H43126
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect C19-1 (ICR+) and C19-2
(ICR-) of connector ”E”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1162/81 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1162/81 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1583
05-1394
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
FE
DLC3
CG
(c)
(d)
DC
(e)
DTC B1162/81
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H42819
H40938
(f)
H43094
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1162/81 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1162/81 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 60-61 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1584
05-1395
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE
(a)
Roof Wire No.2
Curtain
Floor Wire
Shield
Squib RH
F E
D C
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
(b)
B
BK2
ICR-
Disconnect the floor wire connector from the roof wire
No.2.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BK2-2 (ICR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
BK2-1 (ICR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
ICR+
H42820
H42497
NG
H42847
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
9
CHECK ROOF WIRE NO.2
Roof Wire No.2
Curtain
Floor Wire
Shield
Squib RH
F E
D C
(a)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
B
C19
ICR+
H42821
C89244
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C19-1 (ICR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
C19-2 (ICR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
ICR-
H43067
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ROOF WIRE NO.2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1585
05-1396
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IVZ-01
B1163/82 SHORT IN CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB (RH)
CIRCUIT (TO B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib RH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the curtain shield airbag
assy RH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1163/82 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the curtain shield squib RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in curtain shield squib RH wire harness (to
B+)
Curtain shield squib RH malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B1163/82
Curtain shield airbag assy RH (Curtain shield squib RH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Roof wire No.2 (w/ Rear seat entertainment system)
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1376 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK VEHICLE CONDITION
Check whether or not the vehicle is equipped with the rear seat entertainment system.
Result:
A: w/o Rear seat entertainment system
B: w/ Rear seat entertainment system
B
Go to step 5
A
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
D C
(c)
(d)
B
C19
ICR+
H41465
ICR-
H43068
(e)
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the curtain shield airbag assy RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C19-1 (ICR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
C19-2 (ICR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1586
05-1397
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Floor Wire
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
D
C
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
C19
ICR+
ICR-
Service Wire
DLC3
CG
H01020
C89252
H10600
DTC B1163/82
TC
H11643
H42131
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
(d) Using a service wire, connect C19-1 (ICR+) and C19-2
(ICR-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j)
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1163/82 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1163/82 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1587
05-1398
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
D C
DLC3
CG
H01021
H10600
DTC B1163/82
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H11643
(f)
H40939
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1163/82 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1163/82 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 60-38 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1588
05-1399
DIAGNOSTICS
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB (RH) CIRCUIT
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
F E
DC
B
ICR+
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
ICRC19
H42818
H43068
-
H43091
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the curtain shield airbag assy RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C19-1 (ICR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
C19-2 (ICR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
Go to step 8
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1589
05-1400
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
DC
F E
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
ICR+
C19
ICR-
Service Wire
DLC3
CG
H43102
C89252
H10600
DTC B1163/82
TC
H11643
H43127
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
(d) Using a service wire, connect C19-1 (ICR+) and C19-2
(ICR-) of connector ”E”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j)
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1163/82 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1163/82 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1590
05-1401
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB RH)
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
Curtain Shield
Squib RH
FE
DLC3
CG
H42819
H40939
(c)
(d)
(e)
DC
DTC B1163/82
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H43095
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1163/82 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1163/82 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY RH
(SEE PAGE 60-38 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1591
05-1402
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE
(a)
(b)
Roof Wire No.2
Curtain
Floor Wire
Shield
Squib RH
F E
D C
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
B
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
BK2
ICR+
ICRH42820
H42497
H42847
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the floor wire connector from the roof wire
No.2.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BK2-2 (ICR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
BK2-1 (ICR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
9
CHECK ROOF WIRE NO.2
Roof Wire No.2
Curtain
Floor Wire
Shield
Squib RH
F E
D C
(a)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
B
C19
ICR+
H42821
C89244
ICR-
H43067
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below when the ignition switch remains in the ON position.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C19-1 (ICR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
C19-2 (ICR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ROOF WIRE NO.2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1592
05-1403
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IW1-01
B1165/87 SHORT IN CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB (LH)
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the curtain shield airbag
assy LH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1165/87 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the curtain shield squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
B1165/87
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between ICL+ wire harness and ICL- wire
harness of curtain shield squib LH
Curtain shield squib LH malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Curtain shield airbag assy LH (Curtain shield squib LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
C18
Curtain Shield Squib LH
Y
1
(*1)
Y-B
2
(*1)
9
A16 ICL+
10
A16 ICL-
*1: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
H01454
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1593
05-1404
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
CHECK CONNECTOR
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait at least for 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the curtain shield airbag assy LH.
Check that the floor wire No.2 connector (on the curtain shield airbag assy LH side) is not damaged.
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, or the claw of the lock is not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
(a)
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
D C
Floor Wire No.2
(b)
B
ICL+
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
ICL-
Disconnect the connector from the airbag sensor assy
center.
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”B” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C18-1 (ICL+) C18-2 (ICL-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
C18
H41469
H43069
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1594
05-1405
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
D C
DLC3
CG
H01017
H10600
(c)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(d)
(e)
(f)
DTC B1165/87
TC
H11648
H42132
(g)
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1165/87 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1165/87 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1595
05-1406
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH)
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
DC
(c)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(d)
(e)
DLC3
CG
DTC B1165/87
(f)
(g)
(h)
TC
H01018
H10600
H11648
H42133
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy
LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1165/87 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1165/87 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(SEE PAGE 60-38 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1596
05-1407
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IW3-01
B1166/88 OPEN IN CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB (LH)
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the curtain shield airbag
assy LH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1166/88 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the curtain shield squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
B1166/88
Open circuit in ICL+ wire harness or ICL- wire harness of
curtain shield squib LH
Curtain shield squib LH malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Curtain shield airbag assy LH (Curtain shield squib LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1403 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
D C
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
B
ICL+
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
ICLC18
H41469
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the curtain shield airbag assy LH.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C18-1 (ICL+) C18-2 (ICL-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
H43069
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1597
05-1408
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
D
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
C
C18
ICL+
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
ICLService Wire
DLC3
CG
DTC B1166/88
TC
H01017
C89252
H10600 H11649
H42134
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect C18-1 (ICL+) and C18-2
(ICL-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1166/88 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1166/88 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1598
05-1409
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH)
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
DC
(c)
(d)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(e)
DLC3
(f)
DTC B1166/88
CG
H01018
H10600
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H11649
H40945
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy
LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1166/88 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1166/88 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(SEE PAGE 60-38 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1599
05-1410
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IW5-01
B1167/85 SHORT IN CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB (LH)
CIRCUIT (TO GROUND)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the curtain shield airbag
assy LH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1167/85 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the curtain shield squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in curtain shield squib LH wire harness (to
ground)
Curtain shield squib LH malfunction
Airbag sensor assy malfunction
B1167/85
Curtain shield airbag assy LH (Curtain shield squib LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1403 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
D C
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
B
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
C18
ICL+
H41469
ICL-
H43069
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the curtain shield airbag assy LH.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C18-1 (ICL+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
C18-2 (ICL-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1600
05-141 1
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
Airbag
Sensor
D C
Assy
C18
Center
ICL+
ICLService Wire
DLC3
CG
H01017
C89252
H10600
DTC B1167/85
TC
H11646
H42135
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect C18-1 (ICL+) and C18-2
(ICL-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1167/85 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1167/85 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1601
05-1412
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH)
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
DC
DLC3
CG
H01018
H10600
(c)
(d)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(e)
(f)
DTC B1167/85
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H11646
H40947
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy
LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1167/85 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1167/85 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(SEE PAGE 60-38 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1602
05-1413
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IW7-01
B1168/86 SHORT IN CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB (LH)
CIRCUIT (TO B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The curtain shield squib LH circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the curtain shield airbag
assy LH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1168/86 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the curtain shield squib LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in curtain shield squib LH wire harness (to
B+)
Curtain shield squib LH malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
B1168/86
Curtain shield airbag assy LH (Curtain shield squib LH)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1403 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FLOOR WIRE NO.2(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH CIRCUIT)
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
D C
C18
ICL+
H41469
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
B
A Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
ICL-
H43069
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the curtain shield airbag assy LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C18-1 (ICL+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
C18-2 (ICL-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE NO.2
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1603
05-1414
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
D
(a)
(b)
Floor Wire No.2
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
C
C18
ICL+
ICL-
Service Wire
DLC3
CG
H01017
C89252
H10600
DTC B1168/86
TC
H11647
H42136
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
(d) Using a service wire, connect C18-1 (ICL+) and C18-2
(ICL-) of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j)
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1168/86 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1168/86 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1604
05-1415
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH(CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB LH)
(a)
(b)
Curtain Shield
Squib LH
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
DTC B1168/86
CG
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H01018
H10600 H11647
(f)
H40949
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy
LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1168/86 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1168/86 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(SEE PAGE 60-38 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1605
05-1416
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWA-01
B1180/17 SHORT IN D SQUIB (DUAL STAGE - 2ND
STEP) CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center, the spiral cable subassy and the horn button assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1180/17 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit.
DTC No.
B1180/17
DTC Detecting Condition
Short circuit between D2+ wire harness and D2- wire
harness of D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step)
D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) malfunction
Spiral cable sub-assy malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Trouble Area
Horn button assy (D squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
D Squib
Y-B
2
1
Y
1
2
Y-R
1
4
Y-G
2
3
14
A17 D+
13
A17 D-
16
A17 D2+
17
A17 D2-
A20
Spiral Cable
Sub-assy
H43063
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1606
05-1417
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
CHECK CONNECTOR
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the horn button assy.
Check that the spiral cable sub-assy connectors (on the horn button assy side) are not damaged.
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, or the claw of the lock is not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-26 )
OK
2
CHECK D SQUIB CIRCUIT(DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP, AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY
CENTER - HORN BUTTON ASSY)
(a)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
F E
D2+
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the connector from the airbag sensor assy
center.
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”B” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - D2-
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
D2-
Color: Orange
H01001
C91344
H41439
NG
Go to step 5
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1607
05-1418
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
F E
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
DLC3
CG
-
H01002
H10600 C89246
DTC B1180/17
TC
H42137
(g)
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1180/17 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1180/17 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1608
05-1419
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK HORN BUTTON ASSY(D SQUIB, DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
FE
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
CG
H01003
H10600
DTC B1180/17
(i)
TC
C89246
(f)
(g)
(h)
H42138
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the connectors to the horn button assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1180/17 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1180/17 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE HORN BUTTON ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-17 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1609
05-1420
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK COWL WIRE
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step) Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
F E
(a)
Cowl Wire
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
A20
Disconnect the cowl wire connector from the spiral cable
sub-assy .
HINT:
The activation prevention mechanism of connector ”B” has already been released.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
D2+
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A20-4 (D2+) A20-3 (D2-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
D2H41440
NG
H43066
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
6
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(a)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step) Spiral
Cable
F E Sub-assy
D2+
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(b)
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”D” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - D2-
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
D2-
Color: Orange
H41441
H43065
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-26 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1610
05-1421
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWC-01
B1181/18 OPEN IN D SQUIB (DUAL STAGE - 2ND
STEP) CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center, the spiral cable subassy and the horn button assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1182/19 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit.
DTC No.
B1182/19
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) wire harness (to ground)
D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) malfunction
Spiral cable sub-assy malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Horn button assy (D squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1416 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK D SQUIB CIRCUIT(DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP, AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY
CENTER - HORN BUTTON ASSY)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step) Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
F E
D2+
(a)
(b)
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
D2-
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the horn button assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - D2-
Always
Below 1 Ω
Color: Orange
H41439
H43064
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1611
05-1422
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
FE
(a)
(b)
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D2-
D2+
Service Wire
Color: Orange
DLC3
CG
H01002
C89252
H10600 C91338
DTC B1182/19
TC
H44127
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect D2+ and D2- of connector
”E”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals, of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1182/19 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1182/19 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1612
05-1423
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK HORN BUTTON ASSY(D SQUIB, DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
FE
(a)
(b)
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
DLC3
CG
DTC B1182/19
TC
H01003
H10600 C89253
H42142
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Connect the connectors to the horn button assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1182/19 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1182/19 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE HORN BUTTON ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-17 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1613
05-1424
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK COWL WIRE
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step) Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
F E
(a)
Cowl Wire
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(b)
A20
Disconnect the cowl wire connector from the spiral cable
sub-assy .
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A20-4 (D2+) A20-3 (D2-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
D2+
D2H41440
NG
H43066
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
5
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(a)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step) Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
F
E
D2+
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - D2-
Always
Below 1 Ω
D2-
Color: Orange
H41441
H43065
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-26 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1614
05-1425
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWF-01
B1182/19 SHORT IN D SQUIB (DUAL STAGE - 2ND
STEP) CIRCUIT (TO GROUND)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center, the spiral cable subassy and the horn button assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1182/19 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit.
DTC No.
B1182/19
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) wire harness (to ground)
D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) malfunction
Spiral cable sub-assy malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Horn button assy (D squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1416 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK D SQUIB CIRCUIT(DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP, AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY
CENTER - HORN BUTTON ASSY)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step) Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
F E
D2+
(a)
(b)
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
D2-
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the horn button assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
D2- - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
Color: Orange
H41439
H43064
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1615
05-1426
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
FE
(a)
(b)
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
D2+
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
D2Service Wire
Color: Orange
DLC3
CG
H01002
H91344
H10600 C91338
DTC B1182/19
TC
H44128
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using a service wire, connect D2+ and D2- of connector
”E”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1182/19 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1182/19 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1616
05-1427
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK HORN BUTTON ASSY(D SQUIB, DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
FE
(a)
(b)
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
DLC3
CG
DTC B1182/19
TC
H01003
H10600 C89253
H42142
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Connect the connectors to the horn button assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1182/19 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1182/19 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE HORN BUTTON ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-17 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1617
05-1428
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK COWL WIRE
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step) Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
F E
(a)
Cowl Wire
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(b)
A20
D2+
D2H41440
Disconnect the cowl wire connector from the spiral cable
sub-assy .
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A20-4 (D2+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A20-3 (D2-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
H43066
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
5
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(a)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step) Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
F
E
D2+
Cowl Wire
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
D2- - Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
D2-
Color: Orange
H01000
C91344
H41441
NG
REPAIR SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-26 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1618
05-1429
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWH-01
B1183/22 SHORT IN D SQUIB (DUAL STAGE - 2ND
STEP) CIRCUIT (TO B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center, the spiral cable subassy and the horn button assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1183/22 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit.
DTC No.
B1183/22
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) wire harness (to B+)
D squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) malfunction
Spiral cable sub-assy malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Horn button assy (D squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1416 .
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
1
CHECK D SQUIB CIRCUIT(DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP, AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY
CENTER - HORN BUTTON ASSY)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step) Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
F E
D2+
(a)
(b)
DC
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(d)
(e)
(f)
D2-
Color: Orange
H01001
C91344
(c)
H41439
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the horn button assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
D2- - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1619
05-1430
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
F E
D2+
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
DC
D2Service Wire
Color: Orange
DLC3
CG
DTC B1183/22
TC
H01002
C891348
H10600 C91342
H44129
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
(d) Using a service wire, connect D2+ and D2- of connector
”E”.
NOTICE:
Twist the end of the service wire in order to insert it
into the connector.
Do not forcibly insert the twisted service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(e) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
(j)
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1183/22 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1183/22 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1620
05-1431
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK HORN BUTTON ASSY(D SQUIB, DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step) Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
FE
(a)
(b)
DC
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
DLC3
CG
H01003
H10600 C91342
DTC B1183/22
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H42144
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Connect the connectors to the horn button assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1183/22 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1183/22 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE HORN BUTTON ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-17 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1621
05-1432
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK COWL WIRE
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step) Spiral
Cable
F E Sub-assy
Cowl Wire
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
A20
(e)
(f)
D2+
D2H41440
H43066
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the cowl wire connector from the spiral cable
sub-assy .
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A20-4 (D2+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A20-3 (D2-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1622
05-1433
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(a)
D Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step) Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
F
E
D2+
Cowl Wire
D C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below when the ignition switch remains in the ON position.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
D2+ - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
D2- - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
D2-
Color: Orange
H01000
C91344
H41441
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-26 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1623
05-1434
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWI-01
B1185/57 SHORT IN P SQUIB (DUAL STAGE - 2ND
STEP) CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front passenger
airbag assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1185/57 is recorded when a short circuit is detected in the P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
B1185/57
Short circuit between P2+ wire harness and P2- wire harness of P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step)
P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Front passenger airbag assy (P squib, Dual stage - 2nd
step)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
A19
P Squib
Y-R
8
A17
P2+
Y-G
7
A17
P2-
3
4
H01454
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1624
05-1435
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK COWL WIRE(P SQUIB, DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Cowl Wire
P Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
D
C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
A19
P2-
R14286
H41424
P2+
H41932
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front passenger airbag assy.
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector ”B” (see page 05-1207 ).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A19-3 (P2+) A19-4 (P2-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
2
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
P Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
D C
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
DLC3
DTC B1185/57
(g)
CG
TC
H01023
H10600 H16840
H42145
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1185/57 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1185/57 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1625
05-1436
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY(P SQUIB, DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP)
P Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
DC
DLC3
CG
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DTC B1185/57
(f)
(g)
(h)
TC
H01024
H10600 H16840
H42146
(i)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the connector to the front passenger airbag
assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1185/57 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1185/57 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-29 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1626
05-1437
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWJ-01
B1186/58 OPEN IN P SQUIB (DUAL STAGE - 2ND
STEP) CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front passenger
airbag assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1186/58 is recorded when an open circuit is detected in the P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
B1186/58
Open circuit in P2+ wire harness or P2- wire harness of P
squib (Dual stage - 2nd step)
P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Front passenger airbag assy (P squib, Dual stage - 2nd
step)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1434 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK COWL WIRE(P SQUIB, DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP CIRCUIT)
P Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
D
(a)
(b)
Cowl Wire
C
B
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
A19
P2-
R14286
H41424
P2+
H41932
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front passenger airbag assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A19-3 (P2+) A19-4 (P2-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1627
05-1438
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a)
(b)
P Squib
Cowl Wire
(Dual stage
Airbag
- 2nd step)
Sensor
D C
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
A19
P2+
(e)
(f)
(g)
P2SST
(h)
DLC3
DTC B1186/58
CG
HINT:
Codes other than code B1186/58 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
TC
H01023
H16853
H10600 H16841
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using SST, connect A19-3 (P2+) and A19-4 (P2-) of
connector ”C”.
SST 09843-18040
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1186/58 is not output.
H41981
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1628
05-1439
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY(P SQUIB, DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP)
P Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
DC
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
CG
H01024
H10600
DTC B1186/58
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H16841
(f)
H42148
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the SST from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the front passenger airbag
assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1186/58 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1186/58 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-29 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1629
05-1440
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWK-01
B1187/55 SHORT IN P SQUIB (DUAL STAGE - 2ND
STEP) CIRCUIT (TO GROUND)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front passenger
airbag assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1187/55 is recorded when a short to ground is detected in the P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit.
DTC No.
B1187/55
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) wire harness (to ground)
P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Front passenger airbag assy (P squib, Dual stage - 2nd
step)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1434 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK COWL WIRE(P SQUIB, DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP CIRCUIT)
P Squib
Cowl Wire
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
D
C
B
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
A19
P2-
R14286
H41424
P2+
H41932
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front passenger airbag assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A19-3 (P2+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A19-4 (P2-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1630
05-1441
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
P Squib
Cowl Wire
(Dual stage
Airbag
- 2nd step)
Sensor
Assy
D C
Center
(a)
(b)
P2+
(d)
(c)
A19
(e)
(f)
(g)
P2SST
DLC3
CG
(h)
DTC B1187/55
HINT:
Codes other than code B1187/55 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
TC
H01023
H16853
H10600 H16838
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using SST, connect A19-3 (P2+) and A19-4 (P2-) of
connector ”C”.
SST 09843-18040
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1187/55 is not output.
H41983
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1631
05-1442
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY(P SQUIB, DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP)
P Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
DC
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
CG
H01024
H10600
DTC B1187/55
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H16838
(f)
H42150
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the SST from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the front passenger airbag
assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1187/55 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1187/55 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(SEE PAGE 05-1215 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1632
05-1443
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWM-01
B1188/56 SHORT IN P SQUIB (DUAL STAGE - 2ND
STEP) CIRCUIT (TO B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assy center and the front passenger
airbag assy.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
DTC B1188/56 is recorded when a short to B+ is detected in the P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) circuit.
DTC No.
B1188/56
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) wire harness (to B+)
P squib (Dual stage - 2nd step) malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Front passenger airbag assy (P squib, Dual stage - 2nd
step)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1434 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK COWL WIRE(P SQUIB, DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP CIRCUIT)
P Squib Cowl Wire
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
D
C
B
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
A
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
A19
P2-
R14286
H41424
P2+
H41932
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center and the front passenger airbag assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A19-3 (P2+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A19-4 (P2-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COWL WIRE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1633
05-1444
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
P Squib
Cowl Wire
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
D
C
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
A19
P2+
(e)
P2-
(f)
SST
DLC3
(g)
(h)
(i)
DTC B1188/56
(j)
CG
TC
H01023
H16853
H10600 H16839
H41985
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
SST 09843-18040
Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assy center.
Using SST, connect A19-3 (P2+) and A19-4 (P2-) of
connector ”C”.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1188/56 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1188/56 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1634
05-1445
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY(P SQUIB, DUAL STAGE - 2ND STEP)
P Squib
(Dual stage
- 2nd step)
DC
(a)
(b)
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
Center
(c)
(d)
(e)
DLC3
CG
DTC B1188/56
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
TC
H01024
H10600 H16839
H42152
(j)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the SST from connector ”C”.
Connect the connector to the front passenger airbag
assy.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at
least 60 seconds.
Check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1188/56 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1188/56 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(SEE PAGE 60-29 )
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
HINT:
Before performing the simulation method, check that the airbag sensor assy center is in check mode
(see page 05-1218 ).
Perform the simulation method by selecting the check mode with the hand-held tester (see page
05-1218 ).
After selecting the check mode, perform the simulation method by wiggling each connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on a city or rough road (see page 05-1218 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1635
05-1446
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1771
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWO-01
PASSENGER SIDE BUCKLE SWITCH
CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The passenger side buckle switch circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the front seat inner
belt assy RH (buckle switch RH).
DTC B1771 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the passenger side buckle switch circuit.
Troubleshoot DTC B1771 first when the DTC B1771 and B1795 are output simultaneously.
DTC No.
B1771
DTC Detecting Condition
When the occupant classification ECU receives a line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or B+ short signal
in the passenger side buckle switch circuit for 2 seconds.
Passenger side buckle switch malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
Front seat inner belt assy RH (Buckle switch RH)
Front seat wire RH
Occupant classification ECU
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1771 of the occupant classification system.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1636
05-1447
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Occupant Classification ECU
B17
Buckle SW RH
L
9
O6 BSW
GR
5
O6 BGND
2
1
H43432
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1637
05-1448
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front RH seat assy installation bolts to see the under surface of seat cushion.
In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1771 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1771 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the occupant classification ECU and the front
seat inner belt assy RH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1638
05-1449
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO B+)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Front Seat Wire RH
D
(b)
(c)
(d)
A
C
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy RH
(a)
B
BGND
O6
Disconnect the connectors from the occupant classification ECU and the front seat inner belt assy RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O6-9 (BSW) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O6-5 (BGND) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
BSW
H43103
H43111
H43130
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
4
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (OPEN)
Front Seat Wire RH
Occupant
Classification ECU
A
D
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy RH
C
B
B17
O6
BGND
2
1
Service Wire
H43104
H43698 H43111
BSW
H43418
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect B17-1 and B17-2 of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O6-9 (BSW) O6-5 (BGND)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1639
05-1450
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (SHORT)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Front Seat Wire RH
(a)
(b)
A
D
C
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy RH
B
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O6-9 (BSW) O6-5 (BGND)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
BGND
O6
BSW
H43103
H43111
H43130
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
6
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO GROUND)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Front Seat Wire RH
A
D
C
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy RH
B
O6
H43103
H43111
BGND
(a)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O6-9 (BSW) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O6-5 (BGND) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
BSW
H43130
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1640
05-1451
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RECHECK DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification ECU and the front seat inner belt assy RH.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(g) Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1771 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1771 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
8
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY RH
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the front seat inner belt assy RH (see page 72-1 1, 72-19 ).
(d) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f)
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(h) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(i)
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1771 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1771 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1641
05-1452
DIAGNOSTICS
9
(a)
(b)
(c)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
11
(a)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
10
(a)
-
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1642
05-1453
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1780
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWP-02
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR
FRONT LH CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The occupant classification sensor front LH circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor front LH.
DTC B1780 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification sensor front LH circuit.
DTC No.
B1780
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When the occupant classification ECU receives a line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or B+ short signal
in the occupant classification sensor front LH circuit for 2
seconds.
Occupant classification sensor front LH malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Seat adjuster frame assy
(Occupant classification sensor front LH)
Front seat wire RH
Occupant classification ECU
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for the DTC B1780 of the occupant classification system.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
WIRING DIAGRAM
O8 Occupant Classification Sensor Front LH
SVC1
SIG1
SGD1
Occupant Classification ECU
R
11
O7 SVC1
SB
7
O7 SIG1
G
1
O7 SGD1
1
2
3
H43062
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1643
05-1454
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front RH seat assy installation bolts to see the under surface of seat cushion.
In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1780 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1780 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor front LH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1644
05-1455
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO B+)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Front LH
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
D
A
C
Front Seat
Wire RH
SGD1
B
O7
SIG1
SVC1
H43105
H43111
Disconnect the connectors from the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor front LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-1 (SGD1) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O7-7 (SIG1) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O7-1 1 (SVC1) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
H43474
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
4
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (OPEN)
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Front LH
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect O8-1 (SVC1) and O8-3
(SGD1), and connect O8-2 (SIG1) and O8-3 (SGD1) of
connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Front Seat Wire RH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
D
A
C
B
O8
Service Wire
SGD1 O7
SGD1
SVC1
H43106
H43699 H43111
SIG1
SIG1
Service Wire
SVC1
H43475
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-7 (SIG1) O7-1 (SGD1)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O7-1 1 (SVC1) O7-1 (SGD1)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1645
05-1456
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (SHORT)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Front LH
D
(a)
(b)
A
C
Front Seat
Wire RHSGD1
B
O7
SIG1
SVC1
H43105
H43111
H43474
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-7 (SIG1) O7-1 (SGD1)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-1 1 (SVC1) O7-1 (SGD1)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-7 (SIG1) O7-1 1 (SVC1)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
6
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO GROUND)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Front LH
D
A
C
Front Seat
Wire RH SGD1
SIG1
H43105
H43111
B
O7
SVC1
H43474
(a)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-1 (SGD1) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-7 (SIG1) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-1 1 (SVC1) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1646
05-1457
DIAGNOSTICS
7
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
HINT:
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RECHECK DTC
Connect the connectors to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor
front LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1780 is not output.
(e)
(f)
(g)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1780 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle when possible.
9
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1647
05-1458
DIAGNOSTICS
10
(a)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
RECHECK DTC
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f)
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1780 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1780 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
END
12
(a)
(b)
(c)
13
(a)
REPLACE SEAT ADJUSTER FRAME ASSY
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the seat adjuster frame assy (see page 72-1 1, 72-19 ).
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1648
05-1459
DIAGNOSTICS
14
(a)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1649
05-1460
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1781
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWR-02
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR
FRONT RH CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The occupant classification sensor front RH circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor front RH.
DTC B1781 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification sensor front RH circuit.
DTC No.
B1781
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When the occupant classification ECU receives a line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or B+ short signal
in the occupant classification sensor front RH circuit for 2
seconds.
Occupant classification sensor front RH malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Seat adjuster frame assy
(Occupant classification sensor front RH)
Front seat wire RH
Occupant classification ECU
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1781 of the occupant classification system.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
WIRING DIAGRAM
O9 Occupant classification Sensor Front RH
SVC2
SIG2
SGD2
Occupant Classification ECU
W
12
O7 SVC2
L
8
O7 SIG2
O
2
O7 SGD2
1
2
3
H43062
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1650
05-1461
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front RH seat assy installation bolts to see the under surface of seat cushion.
In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1781 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1781 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor front RH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1651
05-1462
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO B+)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Front RH
(b)
(c)
(d)
D
A
C
Front Seat
Wire RH
O7
SGD2
B
SIG2
H43105
H43111
(a)
SVC2
Disconnect the connectors from the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor front RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-2 (SGD2) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O7-8 (SIG2) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O7-12 (SVC2) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
H43474
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
4
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (OPEN)
A
C
SVC2
H43106
H43699 H43111
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect O9-1 (SVC2) and O9-3
(SGD2), and connect O9-2 (SIG2) and O9-3(SGD2) of
connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Occupant
Classification
ECU
D
Service
Wire
(a)
(b)
Front Seat Wire RH
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Front RH
B
O9
O7
SGD2
SGD2
SIG2 Service
Wire
SIG2
SVC2
H43475
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-8 (SIG2) O7-2 (SGD2)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O7-12 (SVC2) O7-2 (SGD2)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1652
05-1463
DIAGNOSTICS
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (SHORT)
(a)
(b)
Occupant
Front Seat Wire RH
Classification
Occupant
Sensor Front RH
Classification
ECU
D
A
C
B
O7
SGD2
H43105
H43111
-
SIG2
SVC2
H43474
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-8 (SIG2) O7-2 (SGD2)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-12 (SVC2) O7-2 (SGD2)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-8 (SIG2) O7-12 (SVC2)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
6
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO GROUND)
(a)
Occupant
Front Seat Wire RH
Classification
Occupant
Sensor Front RH
Classification
ECU
D
A
C
SGD2
H43105
H43111
SIG2
B
O7
SVC2
H43474
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-2 (SGD2) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-8 (SIG2) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-12 (SVC2) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1653
05-1464
DIAGNOSTICS
7
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
HINT:
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RECHECK DTC
Connect the connectors to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor
front RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1781 is not output.
(e)
(f)
(g)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1781 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle when possible.
9
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1654
05-1465
DIAGNOSTICS
10
(a)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
RECHECK DTC
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f)
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1781 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1781 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
END
12
(a)
(b)
(c)
13
(a)
REPLACE SEAT ADJUSTER FRAME ASSY
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the seat adjuster frame assy (see page 72-1 1, 72-19 ).
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1655
05-1466
DIAGNOSTICS
14
(a)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1656
05-1467
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1782
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWT-02
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR
REAR LH CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The occupant classification sensor rear LH circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor rear LH.
DTC B1782 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification sensor rear LH circuit.
DTC No.
B1782
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When the occupant classification ECU receives a line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or B+ short signal
in the occupant classification sensor rear LH circuit for 2 seconds.
Occupant classification sensor rear LH malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Seat adjuster frame assy
(Occupant classification sensor rear LH)
Front seat wire RH
Occupant classification ECU
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1782 of the occupant classification system.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Occupant Classification ECU
O10 Occupant Classification Sensor Rear LH
SVC3
GR
5
O7 SVC3
Y
9
O7 SIG3
W
3
O7 SGD3
1
SIG3 2
SGD3
3
H43062
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1657
05-1468
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front RH seat assy installation bolts to see the under surface of seat cushion.
In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1782 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1782 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor rear LH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1658
05-1469
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH(TO B+)
(a)
Occupant
Front Seat Wire RH
Classification
Occupant
Sensor Rear LH
(b)
(c)
(d)
Classification
ECU
D
A
C
B
O7
SGD3
SVC3
SIG3
H43105
H43111
Disconnect the connectors from the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor rear LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-3 (SGD3) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O7-5 (SVC3) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O7-9 (SIG3) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
H43474
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
4
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH(OPEN)
Occupant
Classification
ECU
D
A
C
B
O10
Service
Wire
SVC3
H43106
H43699 H43111
(a)
(b)
Front Seat Wire RH
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Rear LH
O7
SGD3
SVC3
SGD3
SIG3 Service
Wire
SIG3
H43475
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect O10-1 (SVC3) and O10-3
(SGD3), and connect O10-2 (SIG3) and O10-3 (SGD3)
of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-5 (SVC3) O7-3 (SGD3)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O7-9 (SIG3) O7-3 (SGD3)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1659
05-1470
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH(SHORT)
(a)
(b)
Occupant
Front Seat Wire RH
Classification
Occupant
Sensor Rear LH
Classification
ECU
D
A
C
B
O7
SVC3
SGD3
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-5 (SVC3) O7-3 (SGD3)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-9 (SIG3) O7-3 (SGD3)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-5 (SVC3) O7-9 (SIG3)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
SIG3
H43105
H43111
H43474
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
6
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH(TO GROUND)
(a)
Occupant
Front Seat Wire RH
Classification
Occupant
Sensor Rear LH
Classification
ECU
D
A
C
B
O7
SGD3
SVC3
Measure the resistance according to value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-3 (SGD3) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-5 (SVC3) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-9 (SIG3) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
SIG3
H43105
H43111
H43474
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1660
05-1471
DIAGNOSTICS
7
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
HINT:
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RECHECK DTC
Connect the connectors to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor rear
LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1782 is not output.
(e)
(f)
(g)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1782 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle when possible.
9
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1661
05-1472
DIAGNOSTICS
10
(a)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
RECHECK DTC
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f)
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1782 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1782 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
END
12
(a)
(b)
(c)
13
(a)
REPLACE SEAT ADJUSTER FRAME ASSY
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the seat adjuster frame assy (see page 72-1 1, 72-19 ).
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1662
05-1473
DIAGNOSTICS
14
(a)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1663
05-1474
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1783
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWU-02
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR
REAR RH CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The occupant classification sensor rear RH circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor rear RH.
DTC B1783 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification sensor rear RH circuit.
DTC No.
B1783
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When the occupant classification ECU receives a line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or B+ short signal
in the occupant classification sensor rear RH circuit for 2
seconds.
Occupant classification sensor rear RH malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Seat adjuster frame assy
(Occupant classification sensor rear RH)
Front seat wire RH
Occupant classification ECU
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1783 of the occupant classification system.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Occupant Classification ECU
O11 Occupant Classification Sensor Rear RH
SVC4 1
SIG4
SGD4
V
6
O7 SVC4
B
10
O7 SIG4
BR
4
O7 SGD4
2
3
H43062
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1664
05-1475
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front RH seat assy installation bolts to see the under surface of seat cushion.
In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1783 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1783 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor rear RH.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1665
05-1476
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO B+)
(a)
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Rear RH
Front Seat Wire RH
(b)
(c)
(d)
Occupant
Classification
ECU
A
D
C
B
O7
SGD4
SVC4
SIG4
H43105
H43111
Disconnect the connectors from the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor rear RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-4 (SGD4) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O7-6 (SVC4) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O7-10 (SIG4) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
H43474
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
4
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (OPEN)
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Rear RH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
A
D
C
Service
Wire
B
O11
SVC4
H43106
H43699 H43111
(a)
(b)
Front Seat Wire RH
O7
SGD4
SVC4
SGD4
SIG4
Service Wire
SIG4
H43475
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect O11-1 (SVC4) and O11-3
(SGD4), and connect O11-2 (SIG4) and O11-3 (SGD4)
of connector ”C”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-6 (SVC4) O7-4 (SGD4)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O7-10 (SIG4) O7-4 (SGD4)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1666
05-1477
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (SHORT)
(a)
(b)
Occupant
Front Seat Wire RH
Classification
Occupant
Sensor Rear RH
Classification
ECU
D
A
C
B
O7
SGD4
SVC4
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”C”.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-6 (SVC4) O7-4 (SGD4)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-10 (SIG4) O7-4 (SGD4)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-6 (SVC4) O7-10 (SIG4)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
SIG4
H43105
H43111
H43474
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
6
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO GROUND)
(a)
Occupant
Front Seat Wire RH
Classification
Occupant
Sensor Rear RH
Classification
ECU
D
A
C
B
O7
SGD4
H43105
H43111
SVC4
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-4 (SGD4) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-6 (SVC4) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-10 (SIG4) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
SIG4
H43474
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1667
05-1478
DIAGNOSTICS
7
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
HINT:
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RECHECK DTC
Connect the connectors to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor rear
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1783 is not output.
(e)
(f)
(g)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1783 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle when possible.
9
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1668
05-1479
DIAGNOSTICS
10
(a)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
RECHECK DTC
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f)
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1783 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1783 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
END
12
(a)
(b)
(c)
13
(a)
REPLACE SEAT ADJUSTER FRAME ASSY
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the seat adjuster frame assy (see page 72-1 1, 72-19 ).
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1669
05-1480
DIAGNOSTICS
14
(a)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1670
05-1481
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1785
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWV-01
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR
FRONT LH COLLISION DETECTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC B1785 is output when the occupant classification ECU receives a collision detection signal sent by the
occupant classification sensor front LH if an accident occurs.
DTC B1785 is also output when the seat adjuster frame assy is subjected to a strong impact, even if an actual
accident does not occur.
However, when the occupant classification ECU outputs a collision detection signal, even if the vehicle is
not in a collision, DTC B1785 can be cleared by ”Zero point calibration” and ”Sensitivity check”.
Therefore, If DTC B1785 is output, first perform ”Zero point calibration” and ”Sensitivity check”.
DTC No.
B1785
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Seat adjuster frame assy malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Occupant classification sensor front LH sensed large load
Occupant classification ECU
Seat adjuster frame assy
(Occupant classification sensor front LH)
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1785 of the classification system.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1453 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1671
05-1482
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in airbag sensor assy center memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1785 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1785 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
END
4
REPLACE SEAT ADJUSTER FRAME ASSY
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the seat adjuster frame assy (see page 72-1 1, 72-19 ).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle when possible.
5
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 8
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1672
05-1483
DIAGNOSTICS
7
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
HINT:
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
Connect the connectors to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor
front LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1785 is not output.
(e)
(f)
(g)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1785 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
END
8
(a)
(b)
(c)
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
9
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
10
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1673
05-1484
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1786
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWW-01
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR
FRONT RH COLLISION DETECTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC B1786 is output when the occupant classification ECU receives a collision detection signal sent by the
occupant classification sensor front RH if an accident occurs.
DTC B1786 is also output when the seat adjuster frame assy is subjected to a strong impact, even if an actual
accident does not occur.
However, when the occupant classification ECU outputs a collision detection signal, even if the vehicle is
not in a collision, DTC B1786 can be cleared by ”Zero point calibration” and ”Sensitivity check”.
Therefore, if DTC B1786 is output, first perform ”Zero point calibration” and ”Sensitivity check”.
DTC No.
B1786
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Seat adjuster frame assy malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Occupant classification sensor front RH sensed large load
Occupant classification ECU
Seat adjuster frame assy
(Occupant classification sensor front RH)
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1786 of the classification system.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1460 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1674
05-1485
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in airbag sensor assy center memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1786 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1786 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
END
4
REPLACE SEAT ADJUSTER FRAME ASSY
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the seat adjuster frame assy (see page 72-1 1, 72-19 ).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle when possible.
5
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 8
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1675
05-1486
DIAGNOSTICS
7
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
HINT:
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
Connect the connectors to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor
front RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1786 is not output.
(e)
(f)
(g)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1786 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
END
8
(a)
(b)
(c)
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
9
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
10
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1676
05-1487
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1787
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWX-01
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR
REAR LH COLLISION DETECTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC B1787 is output when the occupant classification ECU receives a collision detection signal sent by the
occupant classification sensor rear LH if an accident occurs.
DTC B1787 is also output when the seat adjuster frame assy is subjected to a strong impact, even if an actual
accident does not occur.
However, when the occupant classification ECU outputs a collision detection signal, even if the vehicle is
not in a collision, DTC B1787 can be cleared by ”Zero point calibration” and ”Sensitivity check”.
Therefore, if DTC B1787 is output, first perform ”Zero point calibration” and ”Sensitivity check”.
DTC No.
B1787
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Seat adjuster frame assy malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Occupant classification sensor rear LH sensed large load
Occupant classification ECU
Seat adjuster frame assy
(Occupant classification sensor rear LH)
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1787 of the classification system.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1467 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1677
05-1488
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in airbag sensor assy center memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1787 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1787 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
END
4
REPLACE SEAT ADJUSTER FRAME ASSY
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the seat adjuster frame assy (see page 72-1 1, 72-19 ).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle when possible.
5
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 8
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1678
05-1489
DIAGNOSTICS
7
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
HINT:
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
Connect the connectors to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor rear
LH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1787 is not output.
(e)
(f)
(g)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1787 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
END
8
(a)
(b)
(c)
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
9
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
10
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1679
05-1490
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1788
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWY-01
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR
REAR RH COLLISION DETECTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC B1788 is output when the occupant classification ECU receives a collision detection signal sent by the
occupant classification sensor rear RH if an accident occurs.
DTC B1788 is also output when the seat adjuster frame assy is subjected to a strong impact, even if an actual
accident does not occur.
However, when the occupant classification ECU outputs a collision detection signal, even if the vehicle is
not in a collision, DTC B1788 can be cleared by ”Zero point calibration” and ”Sensitivity check”.
Therefore, if DTC B1788 is output, first perform ”Zero point calibration” and ”Sensitivity check”.
DTC No.
B1788
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Seat adjuster frame assy malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Occupant classification sensor rear RH sensed large load
Occupant classification ECU
Seat adjuster frame assy
(Occupant classification sensor rear RH)
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1788 of the classification system.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1474 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1680
05-1491
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in airbag sensor assy center memory (see page 05-1215 ).
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1788 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1788 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
END
4
REPLACE SEAT ADJUSTER FRAME ASSY
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the seat adjuster frame assy (see page 72-1 1, 72-19 ).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle when possible.
5
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 8
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1681
05-1492
DIAGNOSTICS
7
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
HINT:
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
Connect the connectors to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensor rear
RH.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1788 is not output.
(e)
(f)
(g)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1788 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
END
8
(a)
(b)
(c)
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
9
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
10
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1682
05-1493
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1790
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IX3-02
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The airbag sensor assy center communication circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the
airbag sensor assy center.
DTC B1790 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the airbag sensor assy center communication
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
B1790
When the occupant classification ECU receives a line
short signal, open signal, short to ground signal or B+
short signal in the airbag sensor assy center communication circuit for 2 seconds.
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
Occupant classification ECU
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Front seat wire RH
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1790 of the occupant classification system.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1683
05-1494
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Occupant Classification ECU
8
FSR+ O6
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
W
1
BL1
W
3
1
A18 A18 FSR+
(*2) (*1)
FSR-
4
O6
B
4
BL1
B
2 10
A18 A18 FSR(*2) (*1)
*1: w/ Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/o Curtain Shield Airbag
H43055
H44108
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1684
05-1495
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front RH seat assy installation bolts to see the under surface of seat cushion.
In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1790 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1790 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the occupant classification ECU and the airbag
sensor assy center.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1685
05-1496
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PREPARE FOR INSPECTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to perform the following procedures before troubleshooting to avoid unexpected airbag deployment.
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor assy center.
(d) Disconnect the connectors from the horn button assy.
(e) Disconnect the connectors from the front passenger airbag assy.
(f)
Disconnect the connector from the front seat airbag assy LH
(g) Disconnect the connector from the front seat airbag assy RH.
(h) Disconnect the connector from the curtain shield airbag assy LH.
(i)
Disconnect the connector from the curtain shield airbag assy RH
(j)
Disconnect the connector from the front seat outer belt assy LH.
(k) Disconnect the connector from the front seat outer belt assy RH.
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TO B+)
(a)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
F
E
FSR-
DC
w/o Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
H41715 H44130
FSRFSR+
FSR+
A18
B
A18
w/ Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
H44536
Disconnect the connector from the occupant classification ECU.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-3 (FSR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A18-10 (FSR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
w/o Side and curtain shield airbag:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-1 (FSR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
A18-2 (FSR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
Go to step 13
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1686
05-1497
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (OPEN)
(a)
(b)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
F
E
DC
B
FSR-
FSR+
FSR+
FSRO6
FSR+
FSRA18 (*2)
A18 (*1)
Service Wire
H44130 H44536
H41715 H43694
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect the O6-8 (FSR+) and O6-4
(FSR-) of connector ”E”.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the terminal of the
connector when connecting.
(d) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-3 (FSR+) A18-10 (FSR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
w/o Side and curtain shield airbag:
*1: w/ Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
*2: w/o Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
H44681
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-1 (FSR+) A18-2 (FSR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
Go to step 14
OK
6
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SHORT)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
F
E
FSR-
DC
FSRFSR+
FSR+
A18
w/o Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
H41715 H44130
B
A18
w/ Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
H44536
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the service wire from connector ”E”.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-3 (FSR+) A18-10 (FSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
w/o Side and curtain shield airbag:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-1 (FSR+) A18-2 (FSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
Go to step 15
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1687
05-1498
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TO GROUND)
(a)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
F
E
DC
B
FSRFSR+
FSR+
FSR-
A18
w/ Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
H41715 H44130
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-3 (FSR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A18-10 (FSR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
w/o Side and curtain shield airbag:
A18
w/o Side and Curtain
Shield Airbag
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag:
H44536
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A18-1 (FSR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
A18-2 (FSR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
Go to step 16
OK
8
RECHECK DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification ECU and the airbag sensor assy center.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(g) Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1790 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1790 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1688
05-1499
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle when possible.
10
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
11
(a)
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
12
RECHECK DTC
(a) Connect the connector to the occupant classification ECU.
(b) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(g) Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1790 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1790 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1689
05-1500
DIAGNOSTICS
13
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO B+)
Occupant
Floor Wire
Classification Front Seat
Airbag
Wire RH
ECU
Sensor
Assy
F
A Center
E
D C B
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
BL1
FSR+
FSRH03354
H43116
H43129
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from battery,
and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the front seat wire RH connector from the floor
wire.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BL1-1 (FSR+) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
BL1-4 (FSR-) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
14
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (OPEN)
Occupant
Floor Wire
Classification
Front Seat
ECU
Wire RH
F
E
D C
Airbag
Sensor
Assy
A Center
B
BL1
O6
FSR+
(a)
FSR-
Disconnect the front seat wire RH connector from the floor
wire.
HINT:
Connector ”E” has already been inserted into the service wire.
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BL1-1 (FSR+) BL1-4 (FSR-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
FSR+
FSRH43129
H03354
H43116
Service Wire
H44538
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1690
05-1501
DIAGNOSTICS
15
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (SHORT)
Occupant
Floor Wire
Classification Front Seat
Airbag
Wire RH
ECU
Sensor
Assy
F
A Center
E
D C B
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the front seat wire RH connector from the floor
wire.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BL1-1 (FSR+) BL1-4 (FSR-)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
BL1
FSR+
FSRH03354
H43116
H43129
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
16
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO GROUND)
Occupant
Floor Wire
Classification Front Seat
Airbag
Wire RH
ECU
Sensor
Assy
F
A Center
E
D C B
BL1
FSR+
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the front seat wire RH connector from the floor
wire.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BL1-1 (FSR+) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
BL1-4 (FSR-) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
FSRH03354
H43116
H43129
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1691
05-1502
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1793
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IWZ-02
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The occupant classification sensor power supply circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the
occupant classification sensors.
DTC B1793 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification sensor power supply
circuit.
DTC No.
B1793
DTC Detecting Condition
When the occupant classification ECU receives a line
short signal, an open signal, short to ground signal or B+
short signal in the occupant classification sensor power
supply circuit for 2 seconds.
Open circuit in occupant classification sensors wire harness
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
Seat adjuster frame assy (Occupant classification sensors)
Front seat wire RH
Occupant classification ECU
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1793 of the occupant classification sensor.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1692
05-1503
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
O11
Occupant Classification
Sensor Rear RH
SVC4
Occupant Classification ECU
V
6
O7 SVC4
W
12
O7 SVC2
GR
5
O7 SVC3
R
11
O7 SVC1
1
O9
Occupant Classification
Sensor Front RH
SVC2
1
O10
Occupant Classification
Sensor Rear LH
SVC3
1
O8
Occupant Classification
Sensor Front LH
SVC1
1
H43061
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1693
05-1504
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front RH seat assy installation bolts to see the under surface of seat cushion.
In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not fall down. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat only as necessary.
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1793 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1793 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the occupant classification ECU and the occupant classification sensors.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS, THEN GO TO STEP
1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1694
05-1505
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO B+)
(a)
O7
SVC3
(b)
(c)
(d)
SVC4
SVC2
SVC1
H43111
Disconnect the occupant classification ECU connector
and the 4 occupant classification sensor connectors.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-5 (SVC3) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O7-6 (SVC4) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O7-1 1 (SVC1) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
O7-12 (SVC2) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
4
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO GROUND)
O7
(a)
(b)
SVC3
(c)
SVC4
SVC2
SVC1
H43111
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O7-5 (SVC3) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-6 (SVC4) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-1 1 (SVC1) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-12 (SVC2) Body ground
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1695
05-1506
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (OPEN)
(a)
O7
SVC3
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
SVC4
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
SVC2
O7-5 (SVC3) O10-1 (SVC3)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O7-6 (SVC4) O11-1 (SVC4)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O7-1 1 (SVC1) O8-1 (SVC1)
Always
Below 1 Ω
O7-12 (SVC2) O9-1 (SVC2)
Always
Below 1 Ω
SVC1
H43111
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
6
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (SHORT)
(a)
O7
SVC3
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
SVC4
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
SVC2
O7-5 (SVC3) O7-6 (SVC4)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-6 (SVC4) O7-1 1 (SVC1)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-1 1 (SVC1) O7-12 (SVC2)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-12 (SVC2) O7-5 (SVC3)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-12 (SVC2) O7-6 (SVC4)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
O7-1 1 (SVC1) O7-5 (SVC3)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
SVC1
H43111
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE RH
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1696
05-1507
DIAGNOSTICS
7
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
HINT:
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RECHECK DTC
Connect the occupant classification ECU connector and the 4 occupant classification sensor connectors.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1793 is not output.
(e)
(f)
(g)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1793 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle when possible.
9
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1697
05-1508
DIAGNOSTICS
10
(a)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
RECHECK DTC
(a) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to clear the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC cannot be cleared.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f)
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1793 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1793 may be output at this time, but they are related to this check.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
END
12
(a)
(b)
(c)
13
(a)
REPLACE SEAT ADJUSTER FRAME ASSY
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the seat adjuster frame assy (see page 72-1 1, 72-19 ).
CHECK PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1698
05-1509
DIAGNOSTICS
14
(a)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1699
05-1510
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1795
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IX0-03
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC B1795 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification ECU.
Troubleshoot DTC B1771 first when the DTC B1771 and B1795 are output simultaneously.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
B1795
Occupant classification ECU circuit malfunction
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
When the occupant classification ECU receives a short to
ground signal in the passenger side buckle switch circuit
for 2 seconds.
The occupant classification ECU receives the ignition
switch LOCK to ON signal 50 times in a row when a malfunction occurs in the power circuit for the occupant classification ECU (LOCK to ON to LOCK should be counted
as once).
Trouble Area
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat wire RH
ECU-B Fuse
Front seat inner belt assy RH (Buckle switch RH)
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for DTC B1795 of the occupant classification sensor.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1700
05-151 1
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
CHECK DTC
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait for at least 10 seconds.
Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
Result:
A: DTC B1771 and B1795 are output.
B: DTC B1795 is output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1771 and B1795 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
A
GO TO DTC B1771 (SEE PAGE 05-1446 )
B
2
(a)
CHECK FUSE
Check the ECU-B fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS(SOURCE VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
O6
+B
GND
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
H43112
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the ”O6” connector from the occupant classification ECU.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage and resistance according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
O6-1 (+B) - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
O6-3 (GND) Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS OR
BATTERY
OK
CHECK USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1701
05-1512
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
5
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
6
(a)
-
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1702
05-1513
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1796
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IX1-01
SLEEP OPERATION FAILURE OF
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
During sleep mode, the occupant classification ECU reads the condition of each sensor while the ignition
switch is off. In this mode, if occupant classification ECU detects an internal malfunction, DTC B1796 is output.
DTC No.
B1796
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Occupant classification ECU
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the supplemental restraint system,
perform troubleshooting for the DTC B1796 of the occupant classification ECU.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be read.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Clear the DTCs stored in memory (see page 05-1215 ).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification ECU memory and then in the airbag sensor assy
center memory.
Use the hand-held tester to check the DTC of the occupant classification ECU, otherwise the DTC
cannot be cleared.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position, and wait for at least 10 seconds.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Using the hand-held tester, check the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
OK:
DTC B1796 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1796 may be output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1703
05-1514
DIAGNOSTICS
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page 60-64 ).
3
(a)
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Zero point calibration” (see page 05-1203 ).
OK:
The ”COMPLETED” is displayed.
4
(a)
-
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
Using the hand-held tester, perform ”Sensitivity check” (see page 05-1203 ).
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1704
05-1218
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05MOH-01
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
Hand-held Tester
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
DLC3
SIGNAL CHECK (CHECK MODE)
(USING HAND-HELD TESTER)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Select the ”SIGNAL CHECK”, and proceed checking with
the hand-held tester.
A80020
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1408
05-1207
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IV5-02
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
(a)
CHECK DLC3
The vehicle’s ECM conforms to ISO 9141-2 for communication protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with SAE J1962 and meets the ISO 9141-2 format.
H40173
Terminal No.
Connection/Voltage or Resistance
Condition
7
Bus Line/Pulse generation
During Transmission
4
Chassis Ground Body Ground/ Below 1 Ω
Always
16
Battery Positive Body Ground/10 to 14 V
Always
HINT:
If the display shows UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE when you connect the cable of the hand-held
tester to the DLC3, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and operate the hand-held tester, there is a
problem on the vehicle side or tool side.
If communication is normal when the tool is connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on the
original vehicle.
If communication is still not possible when the tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in the tool itself. Consult the Service Department listed in the tool’s instruction manual.
2.
FUNCTION OF SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Primary check.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position. Wait for at least 2 seconds, then turn the ignition
switch to the ON position. The SRS warning light comes on for approximately 6 seconds and the
airbag system diagnosis (including the seat belt protensioner and occupant classification system) is performed.
HINT:
If trouble is detected during the primary check, the SRS warning light remains on or blinks even after the
primary check period (for approximately 6 seconds) has elapsed.
(b) Constant check.
(1) After the primary check, the airbag sensor assy center constantly monitors the SRS airbag system for trouble.
HINT:
If trouble is detected during the constant check, the airbag sensor assy center functions as follows:
The SRS warning light comes on or blinks.
The SRS warning light goes off, and then comes on. This blinking pattern indicates the source voltage
drop. The SRS warning light goes off 10 seconds after the source voltage returns to normal.
(c) Review.
(1) When the airbag system is normal:
The SRS warning light comes on only during the primary check period (for approximately 6 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the ON position).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1397
05-1208
DIAGNOSTICS
(2)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
When the airbag system has trouble:
The SRS warning light remains on or blinks even after the primary check period has elapsed.
The SRS warning light goes off after the primary check, but comes on or blinks again during the
constant check.
The SRS warning light does not come on when turning the ignition switch from the LOCK to ON
position.
HINT:
The airbag sensor assy center keeps the SRS waning light on if the airbag has been deployed.
3.
FUNCTION OF PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR
(a) Initial check.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(2) The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator (”ON” and ”OFF”) comes on for approximately 4 seconds, then goes off for approximately 2 seconds.
(3) Approximately 6 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, the passenger
airbag ON/OFF indicator will be ON/OFF depending on the conditions listed below.
Condition
”ON” indicator
”OFF” indicator
Vacant
OFF
OFF
Adult is seated.
ON
OFF
Child is seated.
OFF
ON
Child restraint system is set.
OFF
ON
Front passenger occupant classification
system failure
OFF
ON
HINT:
The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator is based on the timing chart below in order to check the indicator light circuit
ON
Ignition Switch
OFF
4 sec.
2 sec.
4 sec.
2 sec.
ON
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator (”ON”)
OFF
ON
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator (”OFF”)
OFF
ON/OFF condition depends on the
front passenger detection results.
H43700
When the occupant classification system has trouble, both the SRS warning light and the passenger
airbag OFF indicator come on. In this case, check the DTCs in the supplemental restraint system first.
Then troubleshoot the occupant classification system if DTC B1150/23 is indicated and troubleshoot
the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator (supplemental restraint system) if DTC B1152/28 is detected.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1398
05-1209
DIAGNOSTICS
4.
(a)
(b)
C93955
H44095
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SRS WARNING LIGHT CHECK
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and check that
the SRS warning light comes on for approximately 6 seconds (primary check).
Check that the SRS warning light goes off approximately
6 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the ON
position (constant check).
HINT:
When any of the following symptoms occur, refer to the ”Problem Symptoms Table” (see page 05-1227 ).
The SRS warning light comes on occasionally, even after
the primary check period has elapsed.
The SRS warning light comes on, but a DTC is not output.
The ignition switch is turned from the LOCK to ON position, both the SRS warning light does not come on.
5.
PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR CHECK
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Check that the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator (”ON”
and ”OFF”) come on for approximately 4 seconds, then
goes off for approximately 2 seconds.
HINT:
Refer to the table in step 3 regarding the passenger airbag ON/
OFF indicator when the ignition switch is turned to the ON position and approximately 6 seconds pass.
6.
(a)
RELEASE METHOD OF ACTIVATION PREVENTION MECHANISM
The activation prevention mechanism is built into the connector for the squib circuit of the SRS.
As explained in the troubleshooting section, insert a piece of paper that is the same thickness as the
male terminal between the terminal and the short spring to release it (Refer to the illustrations on the
next 5 pages).
CAUTION:
Never release the activation prevention mechanism on the squib connector even when inspecting
with the squib disconnected.
NOTICE:
Never release the activation prevention mechanism unless specially directed by the troubleshooting procedure.
To prevent the terminal and the short spring from being damaged, always use a piece of paper
that is the same thickness as the male terminal.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1399
05-1210
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
w/ Side and Curtain Shield Airbag:
To
Occupant
Classification ECU
35
36
9
Front Seat Outer
Belt Assy RH
(Squib)
31
Airbag Sensor
Rear RH
10
27
7
32
(*1)
(*1)
28
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy RH
Curtain Shield
Airbag Assy RH
(Squib)
29
(*2)
8
30
5
25
Airbag Sensor
Front RH
Front Seat Airbag
Assy RH (Squib)
6
26
3
23
4
24
Front Passenger
Airbag Assy
(Squib)
1
19
Airbag Sensor
Assy Center
2
3
13
21
Integration Switch
Assy
20
22
14
16
17
4
5
Horn Button Assy
(Squib)
15
18
Spiral Cable
Sub-assy
25
Airbag Sensor
Rear LH
6
Front Seat Airbag
Assy LH (Squib)
26
7
29
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy LH
8
Curtain Shield
Airbag Assy LH
(Squib)
30
9
31
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
10
Front Seat Outer
Belt Assy LH
(Squib)
32
11
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
12
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
*2: w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
H44135
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1400
05-121 1
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
w/o Side and Curtain Shield Airbag:
9
Airbag Sensor
Rear RH
10
7
To
Occupant
Classification ECU
29
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy RH
30
8
5
26
Front Seat Outer
Belt Assy RH
(Squib)
Airbag Sensor
Front RH
6
25
3
24
Front Passenger
Airbag Assy
(Squib)
23
4
1
22
Airbag Sensor
Assy Center
19
13
2
Telltale Lamp
Assy
20
14
21
3
18
16
Horn Button Assy
(Squib)
15
4
5
17
Spiral Cable
Sub-assy
26
Airbag Sensor
Rear LH
25
6
Front Seat Outer
Belt Assy LH
(Squib)
7
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy LH
8
9
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
10
11
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
12
H44087
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1401
05-1212
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Occupant Classification ECU:
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy RH
(Buckle Switch RH)
5
From
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
6
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Front LH
7
8
1
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Front RH
7
Occupant
Classification ECU
2
8
3
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Rear LH
7
4
8
Occupant
Classification
Sensor Rear RH
7
8
H43077
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1402
05-1213
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
w/ Side and Curtain Shield Airbag:
Airbag Sensor Assy Center Side Connector
4
2
Short Spring
Short Spring
4
Short Spring
Short Spring
Before Release
After Release
Paper
Paper
Short Spring
Connector
Short Spring
16
Before Release
After Release
Paper
Short Spring
Connector
25
Paper
Short Spring
Before Release
Short Spring
Paper
After Release
Short Spring
Paper
Short Spring
H44086
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1403
05-1214
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
w/o Side and Curtain Shield Airbag:
Airbag Sensor Assy Center Side Connector
4
Short Spring
4
2
Short Spring
Short Spring
After Release
Before Release
Paper
Paper
Short Spring
Connector
Short Spring
16
Before Release
Short Spring
Paper
After Release
Paper
Short Spring
Short Spring
H44088
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1404
05-1219
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IV8-02
DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
By accessing the DATA LIST displayed by the hand-held tester, you can perform such functions as reading
the values of switches and sensors without removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST is the first step of
troubleshooting and is one method to shorten labor time.
(d) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(e) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(f)
Following the display on the tester screen, read the ”DATA LIST”.
1.
DATA LIST FOR AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Item
D SEAT POSITION
PASSENGER CLASS
D BUCKLE SW
P BUCKLE SW
#CODES
Measurement Item/
Normal Condition
Range (Display)
Seat position (Driver side)/
FORWARD: Seat position
is forward
FORWARD/BKWARD
BKWARD: Seat position is
rearward
FAIL: A failure is detected
Passenger classification/
NG: A date is not determined
NONE: Vacant
CHILD: Child (less than 36
kg (79.37 lb)) is seated
NG/NONE/CHILD/SMALL/
SMALL: Adult (36 to 54 kg
REGULAR
(79.37 to 119.05 lb)) is
seated
REGULAR: Adult (more
than 54 kg (119.05 lb)) is
seated
FAIL: A failure is detected
Buckle switch (Driver side)/
ON: The seat belt is fastened
OFF: The seat belt is not
ON/OFF
fastened
NG: A data is not determined
Buckle switch (Passenger
side)/
ON: The seat belt is fastened
ON/OFF
OFF: The seat belt is not
fastened
NG: A data is not determined
Number of past DTC recorded/
0
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
Diagnostic Note
-
-
-
-
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1409
05-1220
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DATA LIST FOR OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
Item
IG SW
P BUCKLE SW
PASSENGER CLASS
SENS RANGE INF
FL SENS RANGE
FR SENS RANGE
RL SENS RANGE
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Ignition switch condition/
ON: Ignition switch ON
OFF: Ignition switch OFF
Buckle switch (Passenger
side)/
OFF: Unfasten the passenger side seat belt
ON: Fasten the passenger
side seat belt
NG: Passenger side seat
belt has trouble
Passenger classification/
AF05: Adult (36 to 54 kg
(79.37 to 119.05 lb)) is
seated
AM50: Adult (more than 54
kg (119.05 lb)) is seated
CHILD: Child (less than 36
kg (79.37 lb) is seated
CRS: Child restraint system (less than 7 kg (15.43
lb)) and passenger side
buckle switch is ON, then
7 to 36 kg (15.43 to 79.37
lb)) is set
OFF: Vacant
Sensor range information/
OK: The value of a sensor
is within the range
NG: The value of a sensor
is over the range
Front left sensor range information/
OK: Sensor range is -17
to 27 kg (-37.48 to 59.52
lb)
Min.: Less than -17 kg
(-37.48 lb)
Max.: More than 27 kg
(59.52 lb)
Front right sensor range information/
OK: Sensor range is -17
to 27 kg (-37.48 to 59.52
lb)
Min.: Less than -17 kg
(-37.48 lb)
Max.: More than 27 kg
(59.52 lb)
Rear left sensor range information/
OK: Sensor range is -17
to 37 kg (-37.48 to 81.57
lb)
Min.: Less than -17 kg
(-37.48 lb)
Max.: More than 37 kg
(81.57 lb)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ON/OFF
-
OFF/ON
-
AF05/AM50/CHILD/CRS/
OFF
-
OK
-
OK
-
OK
-
OK
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1410
05-1221
DIAGNOSTICS
Item
RR SENS RANGE
FL SENS VOL
FR SENS VOL
RL SENS VOL
RR SENS VOL
FL SENS WEIGHT
FR SENS WEIGHT
RL SENS WEIGHT
RR SENS WEIGHT
TOTAL WEIGHT
#CODES
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Rear right sensor range information/
OK: Sensor range is -17
to 37 kg (-37.48 to 81.57
lb)
Min.: Less than -17 kg
(-37.48 lb)
Max.: More than 37 kg
(81.57 lb)
Front left sensor voltage/
Min.: 0 V
Max.: 19.8 V
Front right sensor voltage/
Min.: 0 V
Max.: 19.8 V
Rear left sensor voltage/
Min.: 0 V
Max.: 19.8 V
Rear right sensor voltage/
Min.: 0 V
Max.: 19.8 V
Front left sensor weight information/
Min.: -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: 27 kg (59.52 lb)
Front right sensor weight
information/
Min.: -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: 27 kg (59.52 lb)
Rear left sensor weight information/
Min.: -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: 37 kg (81.57 lb)
Rear right sensor weight
information/
Min.: -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: 37 kg (81.57 lb)
Total weight information/
Min.: -68 kg (-88.18 lb)
Max.: 128 kg (220.46 lb)
Number of DTC recorded/
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
OK
-
0 to 4.7 V
-
0 to 4.7 V
-
0 to 4.7 V
-
0 to 4.7 V
-
-17 to 27 kg
(-37.48 to 59.52 lb)
-
-17 to 27 kg
(-37.48 to 59.52 lb)
-
-17 to 37 kg
(-37.48 to 81.57 lb)
-
-17 to 37 kg
(-37.48 to 81.57 lb)
-
-68 to 128 kg
(-149.91 to 282.19 lb)
-
0
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1411
05-1215
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05MOG-01
DTC CHECK/CLEAR
1.
H40173
Normal System Code
(w/o Past Trouble Code)
0.25
ON
OFF
0.25
Normal System Code
(w/ Past Trouble Code)
0.75
ON
OFF
0.25
Trouble Code
(Example Code 11 and 31)
0.5 2.5
4.0
1.5
DTC 11
0.5
Repeat
DTC 31
H13050
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM DTC CHECK
(USING SST CHECK WIRE)
(a) Check the DTCs (Present trouble code).
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait
for approximately 60 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DTC3.
SST 09843-18040
NOTICE:
Connect the terminals to the correct positions to avoid a
malfunction.
(b) Check the DTCs (Past trouble code).
(1) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DTC3.
SST 09843-18040
NOTICE:
Connect the terminals to the correct positions to avoid a
malfunction.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and wait
for approximately 60 seconds.
(c) Read the DTCs.
(1) Read the blinking patterns of the DTCs. Examples,
the blinking patterns for the normal system code
and trouble codes 11 and 31 are shown in the illustration to the left.
Normal system code indication (w/o past
trouble code)
The light blinks twice per second.
Normal system code indication (w/ past
trouble code)
When the past trouble code is stored in the
airbag sensor assy center, the light blinks
only ones per second.
Trouble code indication
The first blinking indicates the first DTC. The
second blinking occurs after a 1.5-second
pause.
If there are more than 1 code, there will be a 2.5-second pause
between each code. After all the codes are shown, there will be
a 4.0-second pause, and they will all be repeated.
HINT:
If 2 or more malfunctions are found, the indication begins
will the smallest numbered code.
If DTCs are inspection without connecting the terminals,
proceed to the ”Tc terminal circuit” on page 05-1522 .
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1405
05-1216
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DTC CLEAR (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
Clear the DTCs.
(1) When the ignition switch is turned off, the DTCs are cleared.
HINT:
Depending on the DTC, the code may not be cleared by turning off the ignition switch. In this case, proceed
to the next procedure.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the DLC3, and then turn the ignition switch to the
ON position.
SST 09843-18040
(3) Disconnect terminal TC of the DLC3 within 3 to 10 seconds after the DTCs are output, and check
if the SRS warning light comes on after 3 seconds.
(4) Within 2 to 4 seconds after the SRS warning light comes on, connect terminals TC and CG of
the DLC3.
(5) The SRS warning light should go off within 2 to 4 seconds after connecting the terminals TC and
CG of the DLC3. Then, disconnect terminal TC within 2 to 4 seconds after the SRS warning light
goes off.
(6) The SRS warning light comes on again within 2 to 4 seconds after disconnecting terminal TC.
Then, reconnect terminals TC and CG within 2 to 4 seconds after the SRS warning light comes
on, connect terminals TC and CG of the DLC3.
(7) Check if the SRS warning light goes off 2 to 4 seconds after connecting terminals TC and CG
of the DLC3. Also check if and the normal system code is output within 1 second after the SRS
warning light goes off.
If DTCs are to cleared, repeat this above procedure until the codes are cleared.
IG S/W
ON
OFF
DTC3
Open
TC
Short
0.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
CG
ON
SRS Warning Light (*)
OFF
1.5 sec.
T1: 0 to ∞ sec.
T2: approx. 6 sec.
T3: 3 to 5 sec.
T4: 3 to 10 sec.
T5: 2 to 4 sec.
T6: 1 to 5 sec.
T7: within 1 sec.
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5 T6 T5 T6 T5 T6 T5 T7
*: The past trouble code in the illustration shows DTC 21 as an example.
H44132
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1406
05-1217
DIAGNOSTICS
Hand-held Tester
3.
(a)
DLC3
A80020
Hand-held Tester
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM DTC CHECK
(USING HAND-HELD TESTER)
Check the DTCs.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Check the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(b) Clear the DTCs.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Clear the DTCs by following the prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
4.
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM DTC CHECK
(USING HAND-HELD TESTER)
HINT:
DLC3
A80020
(a)
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting the supplemental restraint system, perform troubleshooting for the occupant classification system.
Since the DTCs for the occupant classification system
can only be output by the hand-held tester, use the handheld tester to output the DTCs.
Check the DTCs.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Check the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(b) Clear the DTCs.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Clear the DTCs by following the prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1407
05-1203
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05MOF-01
INITIALIZATION
Hand-held Tester
DLC3
A80020
1.
ZERO POINT CALIBRATION AND SENSITIVITY
CHECK
NOTICE:
Make sure that the seat is not occupied before performing
the operation.
HINT:
Perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity check if any of
the following conditions occur.
The occupant classification ECU is replaced.
Accessories (seatback tray and seat cover, etc.) are
installed.
The passenger seat is removed from the vehicle.
The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator (”OFF”) comes
on when the passenger seat is not occupied.
The vehicle is brought to the workshop for repair due to
an accident or a collision.
(a) Zero point calibration and sensitivity check procedures.
HINT:
Make sure that zero point calibration has finished normally, and
then perform the sensitivity check.
(1) Adjust the seat position according to the table below.
Adjustment Component
Position
(2)
(3)
(4)
Slide Direction
Rearmost position
Reclining Angle
Upright position
Headrest Height
Lowest position
Lifter Height
Lowest position
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Perform the zero point calibration by following the
prompts on the tester screen shown in 2 pages later.
HINT:
Refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
OK: ”COMPLETE” is displayed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1393
05-1204
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(5)
Perform the sensitivity check by following the
prompts on the tester screen shown in 2 pages later.
(6) Confirm that the beginning sensor reading is within
the standard value.
Standard value: -3.2 to 3.2 kg (-7 to 7 lb)
(7) Place a 30 kg (66.14 lb) weight (eg. a 30 kg (66.14
lb) of lead mass) onto the passenger seat.
(8) Confirm that the sensitivity is within the standard
value.
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
HINT:
When performing the sensitivity check, use a solid metal
weight (the check result may not appear properly if the
weight made from liquid is used).
When the sensitivity deviates from the standard value, retighten the bolts of the passenger seat taking care not to
deform the seat rail. After performing this procedure, if the
sensitivity is not within the standard value, replace the
front RH seat assy.
When zero point calibration has not finished normally, replace the front RH seat assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1394
05-1205
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
ZERO POINT CALIBRATION PROCEDURE
”1: DIAGNOSIS” - ”1: OBD/MOBD” - ”MODEL YEAR” - ”MODEL SELECTION = HIGH LANDER” Select the option parts - ”9: OCCUPANT DETECT” - Refer to the following screen flow.
DIAGNOSTIC MENU
OCCUPANT DETECT
1: DATA LIST
2: DTC INFO
4: SNAPSHOT
5: ZERO CALIBRATION
6: SENSITIVITY CHK
NOTICE
NOTICE
Please confirm seat
position.
Confirm that
nothing is placed
on the passenger
seat.
Slide: Max rear
Recline: Max upright
Headrest: Max down
Lifter: Max down
PRESS [ENTER] or [EXIT]
PRESS [ENTER] or [EXIT]
NOTICE
Do you wish to
start ”ZERO
CALIBRATION”?
ZERO CALIBRATION
COMPLETED
Perform sensitivity check.
Next, perform the
SENSITIVITY CHECK.
PRESS [YES] or [NO]
PRESS [ENTER]
ZERO CALIBRATION
ZERO CALIBRATION
FAILED
FAILED
Failed to SECURITY
ACCESS.
Perform DTC check and repair.
EEPROM writing error
Please check DTCs
Try again
PRESS [ENTER]
PRESS [ENTER]
ZERO CALIBRATION
FAILED
Sensor range
over malfunction
Front Left ----[
Front Right ----[
Rear Left ----[
Rear Right ----[
]
]
]
]
Sensor information is
expressed as OK, MAX or MIN
in [ ].
If MAX or MIN is displayed,
replace the front RH seat assy.
PRESS [ENTER]
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1395
05-1206
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SENSITIVITY CHECK PROCEDURE
”1: DIAGNOSIS” - ”1: OBD/MOBD” - ”MODEL YEAR” - ”MODEL SELECTION = HIGH LANDER” Select the option parts - ”9: OCCUPANT DETECT” - Refer to the following screen flow.
DIAGNOSTIC MENU
OCCUPANT DETECT
1: DATA LIST
2: DTC INFO
4: SNAPSHOT
5: ZERO CALIBRATION
6: SENSITIVITY CHK
SENSITIVITY CHECK
NOTICE
Beginning sensor
reading should be
-3.2 to 3.2 kg.
(-7 to 7 lbs)
Please confirm
that nothing is
placed on the
passenger seat.
Sensor reading
0.00 kg
PRESS [ENTER] or [EXIT]
PRESS [ENTER]
SENSITIVITY CHECK
Place 30 kg (66 lbs)
weight on passenger
seat. Sensor reading
should be 27 to 33 kg.
(59 to 73 lbs)
Sensor reading
(*1)
0.00 kg
PRESS [ENTER]
*1: kg ⇔ lb
Unit can be changed based on unit conversion setting.
[System Selection Screen]
”1: DIAGNOSIS” - ”9: SETUP” - ”4: UNIT CONVERSION”
- ”WEIGHT” (kg ⇔ lbs)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1396
05-1515
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05267-05
SOURCE VOLTAGE DROP
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SRS is equipped with a voltage-increase circuit (DC-DC converter) in the airbag sensor assy center
in case the source voltage drops.
When the battery voltage drops, the voltage-increase circuit (DC-DC converter) functions to increase the
voltage of the SRS to normal voltage.
A malfunction in this circuit is displayed differently from other codes. The source voltage drop is indicated
when the SRS warning light comes on without showing any DTCs.
A malfunction in this circuit is not recorded in the airbag sensor assy center. The SRS warning light automatically goes off when the source voltage returns to normal.
DTC No.
Diagnosis
(Normal)
Source voltage drop
WIRING DIAGRAM
I15
Ignition SW
AM2
Y
Instrument Panel J/B
IG2
1
1C
GR
6
7
Airbag Sensor
Assy Center
IGN
6
1L
B
5
A17 IG2
F7 FL Block
1
IC1
L-Y
10
AM2
W
1
W
Instrument Panel J/B
W-B
14
1D
1
1L
9
1L
W-B
W-B
28
A17 E2
27
A17 E1
FL MAIN
Battery
IA
H45941
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1705
05-1516
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SOURCE VOLTAGE
(a)
(b)
(c)
IG2
A17
(d)
E2
E1
H40065
(e)
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connector of the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage and resistance according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-5 (IG2) Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
A17-27 (E1) Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
A17-28 (E2) Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
(BATTERY - AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER),
CHARGING SYSTEM AND BATTERY
OK
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Connect the airbag sensor assy center connectors.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery, and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Operate all components of the electrical system (defogger, wiper, headlight, heater blower, etc.) and
check the SRS warning light operation.
OK:
SRS warning light does not come on.
NG
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(SEE PAGE 60-53 )
OK
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1706
05-1517
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IX2-02
SRS WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION (ALWAYS LIGHT
UP, WHEN DTC IS NOT OUTPUT.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SRS warning light is located on the combination meter.
When the SRS is normal, the SRS warning light lights up for approx. 6 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned from the LOCK position to ON position, and then turns off automatically.
If there is a malfunction in the SRS, the SRS warning light lights up to inform the driver of the abnormality.
When terminals Tc and CG of the DLC3 are connected, the DTC is displayed by blinking the SRS warning
light.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1707
05-1518
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C
Control Assembly
G
9
2
MPX+
MPD1 4 G
V 11
A10 MPXA11
(*1) MPD2
(*1)
P5
Power Window Master
SW with ECU
GR 8
Airbag Sensor
Assy Center
G5
Gate Way ECU
MPX1 7 V
MPX2
12
IL2
Short Connector
1
1
BR
R
S31
S30
24
A17 MPX1
G
(*2)
IB2
Passenger Side J/B
7
5
BR
SB
4F
4A
2
S31
2
S30
22
A17 MPX2
BR
*1: w/ Navigation System
*2: w/o Navigation System
*3: w/ Theft Deterrent System
E6
Engine
Control Module
Body ECU
1
IB2
GR
Y
5
3H
12
3J
O
10
6
MPX2 29
W 18
MPX1
B9 MPX2
B10
MPX1
Y
Combination Meter
B
SB
V 31
MPX1
(*3)
1
3E
12
3A
1
IL2
T4
Theft Deterrent ECU
Center J/B
G
5
IF3
1
3C
P
1
C11
21
C11
Y
9
C12
SB
Center J/B
B
11
C11
Instrument Panel J/B
HEATER
13
7
1K
IC
F7 FL Block
FL MAIN
ALT
2 B
W 1
12
3B
R
2
3K
BR
G
Instrument Panel J/B
AM1
1
6
1
2
1A
1C
I15
Ignition SW
W
2
4
AM1
Battery
IG1
IB
H45942
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1708
05-1519
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK CONNECTOR
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Check that the connectors are properly connected to the airbag sensor assy center and the combination meter assy.
OK:
The connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(a)
(b)
Airbag Sensor Assy Center:
(c)
(d)
A17
MPX1
MPX2
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connector from the airbag sensor assy
center.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A17-24 (MPX1) - C11-21
Always
Below 1 Ω
A17-24 (MPX1) A17-22 (MPX2)
Always
1 MΩ or Higher
Combination Meter Assy:
C11-21
H40452
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
(AIRBAG
SENSOR
ASSY
CENTER
COMBINATION METER ASSY)
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1709
05-1520
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK COMBINATION METER ASSY
(a)
Disconnect the connector from the combination meter
assy.
(b)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
C82952
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C11-21 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
8 to 14 V
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-10 )
OK
REPLACE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 60-53 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1710
05-1521
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05269-04
SRS WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION (DOES NOT LIGHT
UP, WHEN IGNITION SWITCH IS TURNED TO ON)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SRS warning light is located on the combination meter.
When the SRS is normal, the SRS warning light lights up for approx. 6 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned from the LOCK position to ON position, and then turns off automatically.
If there is a malfunction is the SRS, the SRS warning light lights up to inform the driver of the abnormality.
When terminals Tc and CG of the DLC3 are connected, the DTC is displayed by blinking the SRS warning
light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
see page 05-1517 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK BATTERY
Measure the voltage of the battery.
Standard: 11 to 14 V
NG
REPLACE BATTERY
OK
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
Disconnect the connector from the airbag sensor assy center.
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and wait for at least 2 seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the table below.
OK:
The SRS warning light comes on.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
(COMBINATION METER - BATTERY)
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1711
05-1 197
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05MOE-01
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
2.
(a)
DESCRIPTION OF SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
General description.
(1) In this system, the airbag sensor assy center installed on the floor under the A/C unit determines
whether or not to activate the SRS airbags (driver airbag, passenger airbag, front seat airbags
and curtain shield airbags) and seat belt pretensioners by receiving the collision signal from each
sensor (excluding the airbag sensor assy center). When there is trouble in the system, the airbag
sensor assy center turns on the SRS warning light on the combination meter assy to inform the
driver.
Description of the dual stage control.
(1) The airbag sensor assy center controls the dual stage deployment of the driver airbag in the horn
button assy and the passenger airbag on the instrument panel. The airbag sensor assy center
controls the dual stage deployment of the driver airbag according to the collision impact, seat
position and seat belt ON/OFF state. It also controls the dual stage deployment of the passenger
airbag according to the collision impact and seat belt ON/OFF state.
Description of check mode (signal check).
(1) This airbag sensor assy center is operable using the check mode of the hand-held tester function. Check mode can detect and output DTC by using a hand-held tester to switch the airbag
sensor assy center to the check mode.
A simulation method is used, if the malfunction cannot be reproduced during troubleshooting (the
malfunction is temporarily solved, etc.). In this case, joggling each connector, or driving on a city
or rough road with the airbag sensor assy center in check mode makes it possible to obtain a
more accurate malfunction condition.
IGNITION JUDGEMENT AND CONDITIONS
Operation in case of front collision.
(1) When the vehicle collides in the hatched area (Fig.1) and shock is larger than a predetermined
level, the airbags (driver and front passenger) are activated automatically. The deceleration sensor of the airbag sensor assy center determines the need for ignition in response to collisions
within the hatched area based on the signal from the deceleration sensor of the front airbag sensor.
(2) Safing sensor of the airbag sensor assy center is designed to activate at a smaller deceleration
rate than the deceleration sensor. As illustrated in Fig.2 below, when both the safing sensor and
deceleration sensor go on simultaneously, current flows to the squib and ignition occurs.
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
Safing Sensor
ON
AND
Airbag Inflating
Deceleration
Sensor ON
Fig.2
Fig.1
H44048
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1387
05-1 198
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag: Operation in case of front side collision.
(1) Electronic safing sensor of the side airbag sensor assy is designed to activate at a smaller deceleration rate than the deceleration sensor of the side airbag sensor assy. As illustrated below,
when both the safing sensor and deceleration sensor go on simultaneously, current flows to the
squib and ignition occurs.
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
Electronic Safing
Sensor ON
AND
Airbag Inflating
Deceleration
Sensor ON
Side Airbag Sensor Assy
H44049
(c)
w/ Side and curtain shield airbag: Operation in case of rear side collision.
(1) Electronic safing sensor of the airbag sensor assy center is designed to activate at a smaller deceleration rate than the deceleration sensor of the airbag sensor rear. As illustrated below, when
both the safing sensor and deceleration sensor go on simultaneously, current flows to the squib
and ignition occurs.
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
Front Seat Airbag Assy
Deployment
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
Electronic Safing
Sensor ON
OR
Airbag Sensor Rear
Airbag Inflating
AND
Deceleration
Sensor ON
H44901
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1388
05-1 199
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
(a)
(b)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION OF PASSENGER OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
GENERAL DESCRIPTION.
(1) In the passenger occupant classification system, the occupant classification ECU calculates the
weight of the occupant based on a signal from the occupant classification sensor. This system
recognizes the occupant to be a child if it detects a weight of less than 36 kg (79.37 lb), and disables the front and side airbags.
(2) This system is mainly comprised of 4 occupant classification sensors that detect the load on the
front passenger seat. The occupant classification ECU controls the system, and the passenger
airbag ON/OFF indicator indicates the ON/OFF condition of the front passenger airbag assy and
front passenger seat airbag assy.
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR.
(1) The occupant classification sensors are installed on 4 brackets connecting the seat rail and seat
frame. Accordingly, when load is applied to the passenger seat by an occupant sitting in it, the
occupant classification sensors register a distortion.
Occupant
Classification Sensor
Occupant
Classification Sensor
Occupant
Classification ECU
Occupant Load
A
Occupant
Classification Sensor
A
A - A Cross Section
H44065
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1389
05-1 196
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
*1: w/ Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
Airbag Sensor Front LH
05IV1-02
Airbag Sensor Front RH
Side Airbag Sensor Assy LH (*1)
Side Airbag Sensor Assy RH (*1)
Airbag Sensor Rear LH (*1)
Airbag Sensor Rear RH (*1)
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy LH (Buckle Switch LH)
Airbag Sensor
Assy Center
Horn Button Assy (D Squib)
Front Passenger Airbag Assy (P Squib)
Front Seat Airbag Assy LH (Side Squib LH) (*1)
Front Seat Airbag Assy RH (Side Squib RH) (*1)
Curtain Shield Airbag Assy LH (Curtain Shield Squib LH) (*1)
Curtain Shield Airbag Assy RH (Curtain Shield Squib RH) (*1)
Front Seat Outer Belt Assy LH (P/T Squib LH)
Front Seat Outer Belt Assy RH (P/T Squib RH)
Combination Meter Assy (SRS Warning Light)
Telltale Lamp Assy (Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator)
ECM
DLC3
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy RH (Buckle Switch RH)
Occupant Classification Sensors
(Front left, Front right, Rear left, Rear right)
H43622
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1386
05-1522
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0526A-05
TC TERMINAL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The DTCs output mode is set by connecting terminals TC and CG of the DLC3.
The DTCs are displayed by blinking the SRS warning light.
HINT:
Make sure that DTC B1281 has not been output. If DTC B1281 has been output, refer to the multiplex
communication system.
When each warning light stays blinking, a ground short in the wiring of terminal TC of the DLC3 or an
internal ground short in each ECU is suspected.
The DTC output mode signal is transmitted through BEAN to each ECU including the airbag sensor
assy center, except for the skid control ECU with actuator. Thus when all systems except the ABS system do not enter DTC output mode, it can be suspected that there is an ECM malfunction.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1712
05-1523
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Control Assembly
2
9
MPX+
V 11
MPD1 4 G
A10 MPXA11
MPD2
(*1)
(*1)
G
8
8
IB2
MPX1 7 V
MPX2
12
IL2
G
(*2)
P5
Power Window Master
SW with ECU
GR
Airbag Sensor
Short Connector
Assy Center
1
1
24
R
BR A17
S31
S30
G5 Gateway ECU
Passenger Side J/B
7
5
BR
4F
4A
SB
2
S31
22
2
BR
S30
A17
Engine
Control Module
Body ECU
GR
1
IB2
10
5
6
O
MPX1
IF3
B10
B9 MPX2
T4
Theft Deterrent ECU
Y
Center J/B
5
3H
V
(*3)
31
W
18
E6
GR
29
E6
MPX1
Combination Meter
1
3E
12
3J
G
Y
21
9
MPX+
C11 MPXC12
SB
1
IL2
J16
J/C
D3
DLC3
O
TC
D
D
20
E5
O
M3
Multi-Display
D
CG
4 W-B
Passenger Side J/B
6
1
4C
4N
O
3
IF3
P
7
TC
*1: w/ Navigation System
*2: w/o Navigation System
*3: w/ Theft Deterrent System
W-B
IC
H45940
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1713
05-1524
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
DLC3:
CHECK WIRE HARNESS(DLC3 - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
TC
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Disconnect the airbag sensor assy center connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
DLC3 (TC) E5-20 (TC)
Always
Below 1 Ω
ECM:
E5
TC
H40173
A67445
H44085
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS(TC of
DLC3 - TC of ECM)
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS(CG of DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
(a)
DLC3
CG
H40173
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
DLC3 (CG) Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS(CG of
DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1714
05-1525
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS(TC of ECM - BODY GROUND)
(a)
ECM:
E5
TC
A67445
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
E5-20 (TC) Body ground
Always
1MΩ or Higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS AND
EACH ECU
OK
4
(a)
REPLACE ECM
Check that the ECM.
Result:
A: Normal system code is output.
B: DTC is output.
C: ECM does not set the DTC output mode.
A
END
B
GO TO INSPECTION PROCEDURE OF DTC
OUTPUT
C
REPLACE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 60-53 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1715
05-1202
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IV3-02
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
Inspector’s
Name
Supplemental Restraint System Check Sheet
VIN
Customer’s Name
Production Date
/
/
Licence Plate No.
km
Miles
Odometer Reading
Date Vehicle Brought In
Date Problem Occurred
Cloudy
Fine
Weather
Temperature
Snowy
Rainy
Other
Approx.
Starting
Driving
Vehicle Operation
Idling
[
Constant speed
Acceleration
Deceleration
]
Other
Road Condition
Details of Problem
Vehicle Inspection, and Repair
History Prior to Occurrence of
Malfunction (Including Supplemental Restraint System)
Diagnostic System Inspection
SRS Warning Light
Inspection
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator
Inspection
1st Time
Remains ON
Sometimes comes on
Does not come on
2nd Time
Remains ON
Sometimes comes on
Does not come on
1st Time
Remains ON
Does not come on
2nd Time
Remains ON
Does not come on
1st Time
Normal System Code
Trouble Code [ Code.
]
2nd Time
Normal System Code
Trouble Code [ Code.
]
DTC Inspection
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1392
05-1228
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05259-22
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
1.
DTCS FOR SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for the code in the table below
(Proceed to the page listed for that circuit.).
HINT:
When the SRS warning light remains on and the DTC output is the normal system code, a voltage
source drop is likely to occur. This malfunction is not stored in memory by the airbag sensor assy center.
If the power source voltage returns to normal, the SRS warning light will automatically go off.
When 2 or more codes are indicated, the code with the lower number appears first.
If a code is not listed on the display chart, the airbag sensor assy center may have failed.
In the case of any malfunction concerning an open circuit, short to ground, or short to B+ due to an
squib, other trouble codes may not detected. In this case, repair the malfunction currently indicated
and then perform malfunction diagnosis again.
Mark in the check mode column:
””: DTC is corresponding to the check mode.
””: DTC is not corresponding to the check mode.
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the Supplemental Restraint System,
perform troubleshooting for the occupant classification system as shown in the chart below.
Check
Mode
SRS
Warning
Light
Short in D squib circuit
Horn button assy (squib)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B0101/14
(05-1238 )
Open in D squib circuit
Horn button assy (squib)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B0102/11
(05-1242 )
Short in D squib circuit (to
ground)
Horn button assy (squib)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B0103/12
(05-1246 )
Short in D squib circuit (to B+)
Horn button assy (squib)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B0105/53
(05-1251 )
Short in P squib circuit
Front passenger airbag assy (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B0106/54
(05-1254 )
Open in P squib circuit
Front passenger airbag assy (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B0107/51
(05-1257 )
Short in P squib circuit (to
ground)
Front passenger airbag assy (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B0108/52
(05-1260 )
Short in P squib circuit (to B+)
Front passenger airbag assy (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B0110/43
(*1)
(05-1263 )
Short in side squib (RH) circuit
Separate type front seat back assy (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Blink
B0111/44
(*1)
(05-1266 )
Open in side squib (RH) circuit
Separate type front seat back assy (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Blink
DTC No.
(See Page)
B0100/13
(05-1233 )
Detection Item
Trouble Area
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1418
05-1229
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
B0112/41
(*1)
(05-1269 )
Short in side squib (RH) circuit
(to ground)
Separate type front seat back assy (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Blink
B0113/42
(*1)
(05-1272 )
Short in side squib (RH) circuit
(to B+)
Separate type front seat back assy (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Blink
B0115/47
(*1)
(05-1275 )
Short in side squib (LH) circuit
Separate type front seat back assy (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B0116/48
(*1)
(05-1278 )
Open in side squib (LH) circuit
Separate type front seat back assy (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B0117/45
(*1)
(05-1281 )
Short in side squib (LH) circuit
(to ground)
Separate type front seat back assy (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B0118/46
(*1)
(05-1284 )
Short in side squib (LH) circuit
(to B+)
Separate type front seat back assy (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B0126/27
(05-1287 )
Seat belt buckle switch (LH) malfunction
Front seat inner belt assy LH
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
ON
B0130/63
(05-1293 )
Short in P/T squib (RH) circuit
Front seat outer belt assy RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Blink
B0131/64
(05-1297 )
Open in P/T squib (RH) circuit
Front seat outer belt assy RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Blink
B0132/61
(05-1300 )
Short in P/T squib (RH) circuit (to
ground)
Front seat outer belt assy RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Blink
B0133/62
(05-1303 )
Short in P/T squib (RH) circuit (to
B+)
Front seat outer belt assy RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Blink
B0135/73
(05-1306 )
Short in P/T squib (LH) circuit
Front seat outer belt assy LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B0136/74
(05-1310 )
Open in P/T squib (LH) circuit
Front seat outer belt assy LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B0137/71
(05-1313 )
Short in P/T squib (LH) circuit (to
ground)
Front seat outer belt assy LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B0138/72
(05-1316 )
Short in P/T squib (LH) circuit (to
B+)
Front seat outer belt assy LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B1100/31
(05-1319 )
Airbag sensor assy center malfunction
Airbag sensor assy center
ON
B1135/24
(05-1320 )
Half connection in airbag sensor
assy center connctors
Electrical connection check mechanism
Airbag sensor assy center
ON
B1140/32
(*1)
(05-1322 )
Side airbag sensor assy (RH)
malfunction
Side airbag sensor assy RH
Floor wire
Airbag sensor assy center
Blink
B1141/33
(*1)
(05-1327 )
Side airbag sensor assy (LH)
malfunction
Side airbag sensor assy LH
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B1148/36
(05-1332 )
Front airbag sensor (RH) malfunction
Airbag front RH sensor
Airbag sensor assy center
Engine room main wire
Cowl wire
ON
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1419
05-1230
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
B1149/37
(05-1339 )
Front airbag sensor (LH) malfunction
Airbag front sensor LH
Airbag sensor assy center
Engine room main wire
Cowl wire
ON
B1150/23
(05-1346 )
Occupant classification system
malfunction
Occupant classification ECU
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Front seat wire RH
ON
B1152/28
(05-1352 )
Passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator circuit malfunction
Telltale lamp assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B1153/25
(05-1360 )
Seat position airbag sensor assy
malfunction
Seat position airbag sensor
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
ON
B1154/38
(05-1366 )
Airbag sensor rear (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor rear RH
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Blink
B1155/39
(05-1371 )
Airbag sensor rear (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor rear LH
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B1160/83
(*1)
(05-1376 )
Short in curtain shield squib
(RH) circuit
Curtain shield airbag assy RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Roof wire No.2
Blink
B1161/84
(*1)
(05-1384 )
Open in curtain shield squib
(RH) circuit
Curtain shield airbag assy RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Roof wire No.2
Blink
B1162/81
(*1)
(05-1390 )
Short in curtain shield squib
(RH) circuit (to ground)
Curtain shield airbag assy RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Roof wire No.2
Blink
B1163/82
(*1)
(05-1396 )
Short in curtain shield squib
(RH) circuit (to B+)
Curtain shield airbag assy RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Roof wire No.2
Blink
B1165/87
(*1)
(05-1403 )
Short in curtain shield squib
(LH) circuit
Curtain shield airbag assy LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B1166/88
(*1)
(05-1407 )
Open in curtain shield squib
(LH) circuit
Curtain shield airbag assy LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B1167/85
(*1)
(05-1410 )
Short in curtain shield squib
(LH) circuit (to ground)
Curtain shield airbag assy LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B1168/86
(*1)
(05-1413 )
Short in curtain shield squib
(LH) circuit (to B+)
Curtain shield airbag assy LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire No.2
Blink
B1180/17
(05-1416 )
Short in D squib (Dual stage 2nd step) circuit
Horn button assy (squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B1181/18
(05-1421 )
Open in D squib (Dual stage 2nd step) circuit
Horn button assy (squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B1182/19
(05-1425 )
Short in D squib (Dual stage 2nd step) circuit (to ground)
Horn button assy (squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1420
05-1231
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
B1183/22
(05-1429 )
Short in D squib (Dual stage 2nd step) circuit (to B+)
Horn button assy (squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
Spiral cable sub-assy
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B1185/57
(05-1434 )
Short in P squib (Dual stage 2nd step) circuit
Front passenger airbag assy (squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B1186/58
(05-1437 )
Open in P squib (Dual stage 2nd step) circuit
Front passenger airbag assy (squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B1187/55
(05-1440 )
Short in P squib (Dual stage 2nd step) circuit (to ground)
Front passenger airbag assy (squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
B1188/56
(05-1443 )
Short in P squib (Dual stage 2nd step) circuit (to B+)
Front passenger airbag assy (squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
Airbag sensor assy center
Cowl wire
ON
OFF
ON
Normal
(05-1515 )
System normal
Voltage source drop
Battery
Airbag sensor assy center
*1: w/ Side and curtain shield airbag
2.
DTCS FOR FRONT PASSENGER OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
HINT:
When DTC B1150/23 is detected as a result of troubleshooting for the Supplemental Restraint System, perform troubleshooting for the occupation classification system as shown in the chart below.
DTC No.
(See page)
B1771
(05-1446 )
B1780
(05-1453 )
B1781
(05-1460 )
B1782
(05-1467 )
B1783
(05-1474 )
B1785
(05-1481 )
B1786
(05-1484 )
B1787
(05-1487 )
B1788
(05-1490 )
B1790
(05-1493 )
Detection Item
Passenger Airbag
OFF Indicator
Trouble Area
Passenger side buckle switch circuit
malfunction
Front seat inner belt assy RH
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat wire RH
ON
Occupant classification sensor front
LH circuit malfunction
Occupant classification sensor front LH
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat wire RH
ON
Occupant classification sensor front
RH circuit malfunction
Occupant classification sensor front RH
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat wire RH
ON
Occupant classification sensor rear
LH circuit malfunction
Occupant classification sensor rear LH
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat wire RH
ON
Occupant classification sensor rear
RH circuit malfunction
Occupant classification sensor rear RH
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat wire RH
ON
Occupant classification sensor front
LH collision detection
Occupant classification ECU
Front RH seat assy (seat frame)
Occupant classification sensor front LH
ON
Occupant classification sensor front
RH collision detection
Occupant classification ECU
Front RH seat assy (seat frame)
Occupant classification sensor front RH
ON
Occupant classification sensor rear
LH collision detection
Occupant classification ECU
Front RH seat assy (seat frame)
Occupant classification sensor rear LH
ON
Occupant classification sensor rear
RH collision detection
Occupant classification ECU
Front RH seat assy (seat frame)
Occupant classification sensor rear RH
ON
Airbag sensor assy center communication circuit malfunction
Occupant classification ECU
Airbag sensor assy center
Floor wire
Front seat wire RH
ON
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1421
05-1232
DIAGNOSTICS
B1793
(05-1502 )
B1795
(05-1510 )
B1796
(05-1513 )
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Occupant classification sensor power
supply circuit malfunction
Seat adjuster frame assy (Occupant classification sensors)
Front seat wire RH
Occupant classification ECU
ON
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat wire RH
ECU-B Fuse
Front seat inner belt assy RH (Buckle switch RH)
ON
Sleep operation failure of occupant
classification ECU
Occupant classification ECU
ON
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1422
05-1200
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05256-33
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
The hand-held tester can be used in step 3, 4, 6, 9 and 10.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS (SEE PAGE 05-1202 )
NEXT
3
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 05-2044 )
DTC IS OUTPUT: CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT (SEE PAGE 05-2044
)
DTC IS NOT OUTPUT: Go to step 4
4
CHECK DTC (Present and Past DTC) (SEE PAGE 05-1215 )
DTC IS OUTPUT: Go to step 5
DTC IS NOT OUTPUT: PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
TABLE (SEE PAGE 05-1227 )
DTC B1150/23 IS OUTPUT: Go to step 5
5
DTC CHART (SEE PAGE 05-1228 )
NEXT
6
CIRCUIT INSPECTION (SEE PAGE 05-1233 TO 05-1521 )
MALFUNCTION CODE IS OUTPUT: Go to step 7
NORMAL CODE IS OUTPUT: Go to step 12
7
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
8
REPAIR
NEXT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1390
05-1201
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CLEAR DTC (Present and Past DTC’s) (SEE PAGE 05-1215 )
NEXT
10
CHECK DTC (SEE PAGE 05-1215 )
DTC CODE IS NOT OUTPUT: Go to step 11
DTC CODE IS OUTPUT: Go to step 5
11
SYMPTOM SIMULATION (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
WARNING LIGHT REMAINS OFF: Go to step 12
WARNING LIGHT IS ON: Go to step 5
12
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1391
05-1 195
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525A-30
LOCATION
Combination Meter Assy:
Telltale Lamp Assy:
SRS Warning Light
Front Passenger
Airbag Sensor
Airbag Assy
Front RH
Airbag Sensor Curtain Shield
Airbag Assy LH (*1)
Assy Center
Passenger
Airbag ON/OFF Indicator
Curtain Shield Airbag Assy RH (*1)
Occupant
Classification ECU
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
Front Seat
Airbag Assy RH (*1)
Spiral
Cable
Sub-assy
DLC3
Horn
Button Assy
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy LH (*1)
Front Seat Outer Belt Assy LH
Airbag Sensor Rear RH (*1)
Side Airbag Sensor Assy RH (*1)
Front Seat Outer
Belt Assy RH
Front Seat Inner
Belt Assy RH
Front Seat Airbag Assy LH (*1)
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy LH
Airbag Sensor Rear LH (*1)
*1: w/ Side and Curtain Shield Airbag
H44115
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1385
05-1 194
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IV0-02
PRECAUTION
1.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS AIRBAG SENSOR
HINT:
In this section, the airbag sensor assy center, airbag sensor front LH, airbag sensor front RH, side airbag
sensor assy LH, side airbag sensor assy RH, airbag sensor rear LH, airbag sensor rear RH and seat position
airbag sensor are collectively referred to as the airbag sensor.
(a) Before starting the following operations, wait at least 90 seconds after disconnection the negative (-)
terminal of the battery:
(1) Replacement of the airbag sensor.
(2) Adjustment of the front/rear door of the vehicle equipped with the side airbag and curtain shield
airbag (fitting adjustment).
(b) When connecting or disconnecting the airbag sensor connector, ensure that all of the sensor are
installed in the vehicle.
(c) Do not use an airbag sensor which has been dropped during the operation or transportation.
(d) Do not disassemble the airbag sensor.
2.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR VEHICLE INVOLVED IN ACCIDENT
(a) When the airbag has not deployed, confirm the DTC by checking the SRS warning light. If there is any
malfunction in the SRS airbag system, perform troubleshooting.
(b) When any of the airbags have deployed, replace the airbag sensor and check the installation condition.
(c) Perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity check if any of the following conditions occur.
The occupant classification ECU is replaced.
Accessories (seatback tray and seat cover, etc.) are installed.
The passenger seat is removed from the vehicle.
The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator (”OFF”) comes on when the passenger seat is not occupied.
The vehicle is brought to the workshop for repair due to an accident or collision.
NOTICE:
When an accident vehicle is brought into the workshop for repair, check the flatness of the body side
that is equipped with the passenger seat. If the flatness is not within 3.0 mm (0.118 in.), adjust it
to the specified range.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1384
05-1227
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
0525C-21
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Proceed with troubleshooting of each circuit in the table below.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See Page
When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the SRS warning
light sometimes comes on after approximately 6 seconds.
SRS warning light circuit malfunction
(Always lights up, when DTC is not output).
05-1517
SRS warning light always comes on even when DTC is not position.
SRS warning light circuit malfunction
(Always lights up, when DTC is not output).
05-1517
With the ignition switch in the ON position, the SRS warning light
does not come on.
SRS warning light circuit malfunction
(Does not light up, when ignition switch is turned to the ON
position).
05-1521
Although a SRS warning light oprates normal, DTC or a normal
system code is not displayed.
TC Terminal Circuit
05-1522
Although terminals TC and CG are not connected, DTC or a normal system code is displayed.
TC Terminal Circuit
05-1522
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1417
05-1222
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
05IV9-02
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER (w/ Side and curtain shield airbag)
A16
A17
A18
H40533
No.
Symbol
A
-
Electrical Connector Check Mechanism
Destination
B
-
Electrical Connector Check Mechanism
A16-1
CSL-
Airbag Sensor Rear LH
A16-2
LBE-
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy LH (Buckle SW)
A16-3
LSP-
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
A16-4
LSP+
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
A16-7
PL-
Front Seat Outer Belt Assy LH (P/T Squib LH)
A16-8
PL+
Front Seat Outer Belt Assy LH (P/T Squib LH)
A16-9
ICL+
Curtain Shield Airbag Assy LH (Curtain Shield Squib LH)
A16-10
ICL-
Curtain Shield Airbag Assy LH (Curtain Shield Squib LH)
A16-11
SFL-
Front Seat Airbag Assy LH (Side Squib LH)
A16-12
SFL+
Front Seat Airbag Assy LH (Side Squib LH)
A16-13
ESCL
Airbag Sensor Rear LH
A16-14
VUCL
Airbag Sensor Rear LH
A16-15
CSL+
Airbag Sensor Rear LH
A16-16
VUPL
Side Airbag Sensor Assy LH
A16-17
SSL+
Side Airbag Sensor Assy LH
A16-18
ESL
Side Airbag Sensor Assy LH
A16-19
LBE+
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy LH (Buckle SW)
A16-20
SSL-
Side Airbag Sensor Assy LH
A17-1
P-AB
Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator
A17-5
IG2
IGN Fuse
A17-7
P2-
Front Passenger Airbag Assy (P Squib, Dual stage - 2nd
step)
A17-8
P2+
Front Passenger Airbag Assy (P Squib, Dual stage - 2nd
step)
A17-9
+SR
Airbag Sensor Front RH
A17-10
P+
Front Passenger Airbag Assy (P Squib)
A17-11
P-
Front Passenger Airbag Assy (P Squib)
A17-12
SIL
Diagnosis
A17-13
D-
Horn Button Assy (D Squib)
A17-14
D+
Horn Button Assy (D Squib)
A17-15
+SL
Airbag Sensor Front LH
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1412
05-1223
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
No.
Symbol
Destination
A17-16
D2+
Horn Button Assy (D Squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
A17-17
D2-
Horn Button Assy (D Squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
A17-20
-SR
Airbag Sensor Front RH
A17-22
MPX2
Combination Meter Assy
A17-24
MPX1
Combination Meter Assy
A17-25
PAON
Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator
A17-26
-SL
Airbag Sensor Front LH
A17-27
E1
Ground
A17-28
E2
Ground
A18-1
FSR+
Occupant Classification ECU
A18-2
FSR-
Occupant Classification ECU
A18-4
CSR-
Airbag Sensor Rear RH
A18-5
SFR+
Front Seat Airbag Assy RH (Side Squib RH)
A18-6
SFR-
Front Seat Airbag Assy RH (Side Squib RH)
A18-7
ICR-
Curtain Shield Airbag Assy RH (Curtain Shield Squib RH)
A18-8
ICR+
Curtain Shield Airbag Assy RH (Curtain Shield Squib RH)
A18-9
PR+
Front Seat Outer Belt Assy RH (P/T Squib RH)
A18-10
PR-
Front Seat Outer Belt Assy RH (P/T Squib RH)
A18-13
SSR-
Side Airbag Sensor Assy RH
A18-15
ESR
Side Airbag Sensor Assy RH
A18-16
SSR+
Side Airbag Sensor Assy RH
A18-17
VUPR
Side Airbag Sensor Assy RH
A18-18
CSR+
Airbag Sensor Rear RH
A18-19
VUCR
Airbag Sensor Rear RH
A18-20
ESCR
Airbag Sensor Rear RH
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1413
05-1224
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER (w/o Side and curtain shield airbag)
A16
A18
A17
H40028
No.
Symbol
A
-
Electrical Connector Check Mechanism
Destination
Electrical Connector Check Mechanism
B
-
A16-1
PL-
Front Seat Outer Belt Assy LH (P/T Squib LH)
A16-2
PL+
Front Seat Outer Belt Assy LH (P/T Squib LH)
A16-3
LSP+
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
A16-6
LBE-
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy LH (Buckle SW)
A16-8
LSP-
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
A16-11
LBE+
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy LH (Buckle SW)
A17-1
P-AB
Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator
A17-5
IG2
IGN Fuse
A17-7
P2-
Front Passenger Airbag Assy (P Squib, Dual stage - 2nd
step)
A17-8
P2+
Front Passenger Airbag Assy (P Squib, Dual stage - 2nd
step)
Airbag Sensor Front RH
A17-9
+SR
A17-10
P+
Front Passenger Airbag Assy (P Squib)
A17-11
P-
Front Passenger Airbag Assy (P Squib)
A17-12
SIL
Diagnosis
A17-13
D-
Horn Button Assy (D Squib)
A17-14
D+
Horn Button Assy (D Squib)
A17-15
+SL
Airbag Sensor Front LH
A17-16
D2+
Horn Button Assy (D Squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
A17-17
D2-
Horn Button Assy (D Squib, Dual stage - 2nd step)
A17-20
-SR
Airbag Sensor Front RH
A17-22
MPX2
Combination Meter Assy
A17-24
MPX1
Combination Meter Assy
A17-25
PAON
Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator
A17-26
-SL
Airbag Sensor Front LH
A17-27
E1
Ground
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1414
05-1225
DIAGNOSTICS
No.
3.
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Symbol
Destination
A17-28
E2
A18-3
FSR+
Ground
A18-5
PR+
Front Seat Outer Belt Assy RH (P/T Squib RH)
A18-6
PR-
Front Seat Outer Belt Assy RH (P/T Squib RH)
A18-10
FSR-
Occupant Classification ECU
Occupant Classification ECU
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
O6
O7
6 5 4 3 21
121110 9 8 7
6 5 4 3 21
121110 9 8 7
H43128
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
+B (O6-1) - GND (O6-3)
R - W-B
Power Source
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
DIA (O6-2) GND (O6-3)
V - W-B
Diagnosis (DLC3)
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
GND (O6-3) Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
FSR- (O6-4) GND (O6-3)
B - W-B
Airbag sensor assy center
communication line (-)
Always
Below 1 Ω
BGND (O6-5) GND (O6-3)
GR - W-B
Passenger side buckle
switch ground line
Always
Below 1 Ω
IG (O6-7) - GND (O6-3)
BR - W-B
Power Source
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
FSR+ (O6-8) FSR- (O6-4)
W-B
Airbag sensor assy center
communication line
BSW (O6-9) BGND (O6-5)
L - GR
Passenger side buckle
switch line
Buckle switch ON
Buckle switch OFF
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
SGD1 (O7-1) GND (O6-3)
G - W-B
Passenger side buckle
switch circuit
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGD2 (O7-2) GND (O6-3)
O - W-B
Occupant classification
sensor front RH ground
line
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGD3 (O7-3) GND (O6-3)
W - W-B
Occupant classification
sensor rear LH ground line
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGD4 (O7-4) GND (O6-3)
BR - W-B
Occupant classification
sensor rear RH ground line
Always
Below 1 Ω
SVC3 (O7-5) SGD3 (O7-3)
GR - W
Occupant classification
sensor rear LH power supply line
IG switch ON, a load is applied to occupant classification sensor rear LH
4.5 to 5.1 V
SVC4 (O7-6) SGD4 (O7-4)
V - BR
Occupant classification
sensor rear RH power supply line
IG switch ON, a load is applied to occupant classification sensor rear RH
4.5 to 5.1 V
SIG1 (O7-7) SGD1 (O7-1)
SB - G
Occupant classification
sensor front LH signal line
IG switch ON, a load is applied to occupant classification sensor front LH
0.2 to 4.9 V
SIG2 (O7-8) SGD2 (O7-2)
L-O
Occupant classification
sensor rear RH signal line
IG switch ON, a load is applied to occupant classification sensor front RH
0.2 to 4.9 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1415
05-1226
DIAGNOSTICS
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
SIG3 (O7-9) SGD3 (O7-3)
Y-W
SIG4 (O7-10) SGD4 (O7-4)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
Occupant classification
sensor rear LH signal line
IG switch ON, a load is applied to occupant classification sensor rear LH
0.2 to 4.9 V
B - BR
Occupant classification
sensor front RH signal line
IG switch ON, a load is applied to occupant classification sensor rear RH
0.2 to 4.9 V
SVC1 (O7-11) SGD4 (O7-4)
R - BR
Occupant classification
sensor rear LH power supply line
IG switch ON, a load is applied to occupant classification sensor front LH
4.5 to 5.1 V
SVC2 (O7-12) SGD2 (O7-2)
W-O
Occupant classification
sensor rear LH power supply line
IG switch ON, a load is applied to occupant classification sensor front RH
4.5 to 5.1 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1416
05-1548
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1241
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQ7-01
BODY ECU SWITCH CIRCUIT DIAGNOSIS
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The following explains when this DTC is output:
This DTC is not output when the switches are operated but fail to make contact. It is only output when the
switches are stuck or held on. For example, this code is output when checking the DTC while the switches
are on:
System is normal:
(a) DTC is output during DTC check with the switches on.
(b) DTC is not output during DTC check with the switches off.
Inspect the switches and replace if necessary. If there is no problem with the switches, inspect the wire harness.
DTC No.
B1241
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Headlamp dimmer switch assy
Wire harness or connector
Multiplex network body ECU
Switch is stuck
WIRING DIAGRAM
Body ECU
18
V
B10 TAIL
17
B10 HEAD
LG
C13
Combination Switch
14
T
Light
Control
Switch
13
H
EL
OFF
Tail
Head
16
W-B
IA
E74075
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1738
05-1549
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and turn the hand-held tester main switch on.
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST and read the display on hand-held tester.
BODY NO.1 (MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU):
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
HEAD LIGHT SW
Headlight control
SW signal/ ON or OFF
TAIL LIGHT SW
Tail light SW signal/
ON or OFF
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ON: Light control switch is in HEAD position
OFF: Light control switch is in except HEAD position
-
ON: Light control switch is in TAIL position
OFF: Light control switch is in except TAIL position
-
OK: Condition sign can be displayed.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
2
INSPECT HEADLAMP DIMMER SWITCH ASSY
(a)
Connector Front View:
C13
E11948
Inspect light control switch.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
14 - 16
TAIL
Below 1 Ω
13 - 16
14 - 16
HEAD
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE HEADLAMP DIMMER SWITCH ASSY
(SEE PAGE 65-25 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1739
05-1550
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(HEADLAMP DIMMER SWITCH ASSY MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU)
Headlamp Dimmer Switch Connector
Front View:
C13
(a)
(b)
E11948
Disconnect the headlamp dimmer switch assy connector
and B10 connector from the multiplex network body ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
C13-13 - B10-17
Always
Below 1 Ω
C13-14 - B10-18
Always
Below 1 Ω
B10-17 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B10-18 - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
C13-16 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B10
B10-18
B10-17
E74263
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1740
05-1551
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
B1244
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQ8-01
LIGHT SENSOR CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a failure in the automatic light control sensor circuit is detected.
DTC No.
B1244
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Automatic light control sensor
Wire
Wi h
harness or connector
t
Multiplex network body ECU
Malfunction of automatic light control sensor
Open or short in automatic light control sensor circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
A23
Automatic Light Control Sensor
CLTS
CLTE
CLTB
Body ECU
R
21
B9
CLTS
W
20
B9
CLTE
G
12
B9 CLTB
4
3
1
E68822
E70389
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1741
05-1552
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness View:
A23 Automatic Light Control Sensor
3
Disconnect the automatic light control sensor connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A23-1 - A23-3
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
1
I39976
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR)
(a)
Wire Harness View:
A23 Automatic Light Control Sensor
(b)
4
Disconnect the B9 connector from the multiplex network
body ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A23-4 - B9-21
Always
Below 1 Ω
I39976
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B9
B9-21
E74263
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1742
05-1553
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
REPLACE AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
OK: Return to normal condition.
NG
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
OK
END
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR)
(a)
Wire Harness View:
A23 Automatic Light Control Sensor
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A23-1 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
1
I39976
NG
Go to step 6
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1743
05-1554
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR)
(a)
Wire Harness View:
A23 Automatic Light Control Sensor
(b)
3
Disconnect the B9 connector from the multiplex network
body ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A23-3 - B9-20
Always
Below 1 Ω
I39976
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B9
B9-20
E74263
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1744
05-1555
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR)
(a)
Wire Harness View:
A23 Automatic Light Control Sensor
(b)
1
Disconnect the B9 connector from the multiplex network
body ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A23-1 - B9-12
Always
Below 1 Ω
I39976
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B9
B9-12
E74263
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1745
05-1604
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQF-02
DOOR LOCK POSITION CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit detects the state of the door lock detection sensor and sends it to the multiplex network body
ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multiplex Communication System
Body ECU
6
B10 MPX1
Power Window Master SW with ECU
7
P5 MPX1
D12
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front LH
16
Door Lock Motor Front LH
P5
Door Unlock Detection SW
3
Front LH
P5
BR
LSSR
1
E
MPX2
8
P5
LSW
J12
J/C
A
B
A
B
A
A
8
BG3
GR
4
LSSR
S
Instrument Panel J/B
14
1D
7
BC1
4
E
E
2 D14
5 D13
Door Key Lock and Unlock Door Lock Motor Rear LH
Door Unlock Detection SW
SW Front RH
Door Lock Motor Front RH Rear LH
Door Unlock Detection
W-B
Passenger Side J/B
SW Front RH
2
10
6
W-B
W-B
W-B
IN1
4L
4M
W-B
BR
V
1
LSSR
4
1E
17
B12 LSWA
B
15
BH1
B
GR
6
LSSR
10
B9 MPX2
O
11
B10 LSWP
3
IA1
B
6 BB1
5
IF3
BR
LG
BR
Y
LSWE
2
2
IN2
IA
1
IB2
GR
E
E
3 B15
3 D15
Back Door Lock Motor Door Lock Motor
Back Door Unlock
Rear RH
Detection SW
Door Unlock Detection
W-B
SW Rear RH
W-B
11 BB1
W-B
A
J14
J/C
BA
13 BC1
W-B
BE
BB
E74082
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1794
05-1605
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Inspect if the door lock system is normal before performing this procedure.
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(FRONT DOOR LOCK POSITION CIRCUIT)
(a)
Power Window Master SW with ECU
Connector Front View:
P5
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
P5-3 - P5-16
Driver side door is locked.
10 to 14 V
P5-3 - P5-16
Driver side door is
unlocked.
Below 1 V
NG
E74383
GO TO POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 05-1935 )
OK
2
(a)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PASSENGER AND REAR DOOR LOCK
POSITION CIRCUIT)
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B10-11 - Body ground
Passenger side door is locked.
Passenger side door is unlocked.
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
B12-17 - Body ground
Rear doors and back door are locked.
One of the rear doors or back door is unlocked.
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B10
B12
B10-1 1
B12-17
E74263
NG
GO TO POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 05-1935 )
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1795
05-1562
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05ETR-02
DRL RELAY CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multiplex network body ECU controls DRL No.2, No.3 and No.4 relays.
The headlamp (High) is connected in serial when the daytime running light system operates.
When Daytime Running Light
System is Operated:
DRL No.2 Relay
To Multiplex Network
Body ECU
DRL No.3 Relay
Headlamp RH (Hi)
DRL No.4
Relay
Headlamp LH (Hi)
To HEAD Relay
I40822
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1752
05-1563
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
The headlamp (High) is connected in parallel when the HI BEAM or FLASH operates.
When HI Beam or Flash is
Operated:
DRL No.2 Relay
To Multiplex Network
Body ECU
DRL No.3 Relay
Headlamp RH (Hi)
DRL No.4
Relay
Headlamp LH (Hi)
To HEAD Relay
I40823
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1753
05-1564
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B No.3
DRL No.2 Relay
R-B
R-B
3
R-B
3
Body ECU
1
3
L-W
3
L-Y
3
3
B11 HRLY
R
2
3
B
3
5
2
1
DRL No.3 Relay
1
2
5
3
Engine Room R/B
H-LP LH LWR
DRL
L-W
4
IK3
L-R
3
B
3
1
2
H-LP RH LWR
B
2
W-B
1
2
2
2
3
H4
Headlamp RH (Low Beam)
R-Y
1
2
H2
Headlamp LH (Low Beam)
3
4
3
R-W
H3
Headlamp RH (High Beam)
R-L
R-W
1
2
1
2
W-B
W-B
W-B
R-W
Engine Room R/B No.3
DRL No.4 Relay
H1
Headlamp LH (High Beam)
R
R-W
1
2
3
H-LP LH UPR 2
3
MAIN
2
Battery
1
5
3
3
W-B
2F
4 HEAD LAMP Relay
2G
1
2
4
2
3
Engine Room J/B
5 H-LP RH UPR
2F
3
1
1
2B
1
2I
F7
FL Block
FL MAIN W
1
16
IK3
P
A
2
B11 DRL
A
J1
J/C
J3
J/C
EB
B
EA
EG
W
3
E74077
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1754
05-1565
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and turn the hand-held tester main switch on.
(c) Select the item below in the ACTIVE TEST and then check the relay operation.
BODY NO.1 (MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU):
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
HEAD LIGHT
Headlamp relay ON/OFF
-
OK: Headlamp (low) comes on.
BODY NO.1 (MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU):
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
DIMMER SIG
DRL No.2 relay ON/OFF
-
OK: Headlamp (high) comes on.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2
(a)
(b)
INSPECT MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
Disconnect the B11 connector from the multiplex network body ECU.
Using a service wire, connect B11-3 of the wire harness side and body ground.
OK: Headlamp (low) comes on.
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B11
B11-3
E74263
NG
Go to step 5
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1755
05-1566
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
Using a service wire, connect B11-2 of the wire harness side and body ground.
OK: Headlamp (high) comes on (decrease mode).
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B11
B11-2
E74263
NG
Go to step 7
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1756
05-1567
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
(b)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
Using a service wire, connect B11-3 of the wire harness side and body ground.
Using a service wire, connect B11-2 of the wire harness side and body ground.
OK: Headlamp (high) comes on.
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B11
B11-3
B11-2
E74263
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1757
05-1568
DIAGNOSTICS
5
(a)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT ENGINE ROOM J/B
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2G-4 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
Engine Room J/B
Connector Front View:
2G
2G-4
E72985
NG
Go to step 6
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (ENGINE ROOM J/B - MULTIPLEX NETWORK
BODY ECU)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1758
05-1569
DIAGNOSTICS
6
(a)
(b)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT)
Disconnect the 2I connector from the engine room J/B.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2I-1 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
Engine Room J/B
Connector Front View:
2I
2I-1
E72985
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ENGINE ROOM J/B
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1759
05-1570
DIAGNOSTICS
7
(a)
(b)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT ENGINE ROOM J/B
Disconnect the 2B connector from the engine room J/B.
Using a service wire, connect 2B-1 of the engine room J/B side and body ground.
OK: Headlamp (high) comes on (decrease mode).
Engine Room J/B
Connector Front View:
2B-1
2B
E72985
NG
Go to step 8
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (ENGINE ROOM J/B - MULTIPLEX NETWORK
BODY ECU)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1760
05-1571
DIAGNOSTICS
8
(a)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT ENGINE ROOM J/B
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2F-2 - Body ground
Connect 2B-1 and body ground
10 to 14 V
2F-5 - Body ground
Connect 2B-1 and body ground
10 to 14 V
Engine Room J/B
Connector Front View:
2F
2F-2
2F-5
E72985
NG
Go to step 9
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (EACH OF HEADLAMP CIRCUIT)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1761
05-1572
DIAGNOSTICS
9
(a)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT ENGINE ROOM J/B
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2B-1 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
Engine Room J/B
Connector Front View:
2B-1
2B
E72985
NG
Go to step 10
OK
REPLACE ENGINE ROOM J/B
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1762
05-1573
DIAGNOSTICS
10
(a)
(b)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT)
Disconnect the 2I connector from the engine room J/B.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2I-1 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
Engine Room J/B
Connector Front View:
2I
2I-1
E72985
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ENGINE ROOM J/B
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1763
05-1596
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05CS6-03
GENERATOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multiplex network body ECU receives an engine condition signal via a generator.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
21
W-G
E9 RL
Generator
L
4
G1
E74084
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1786
05-1597
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK ECM
ECM
Connector Front View:
(a)
E9
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
E9-21 - Body ground
Engine running
10 to 14 V
E9-21
E74382
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2
(a)
INSPECT GENERATOR ASSY
Inspect generator assy (see page 19-17 or 19-42 ).
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE GENERATOR ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (GENERATOR ASSY - ECM)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1787
05-1598
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05ETU-02
PARKING BRAKE SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multiplex network body ECU receives the parking brake switch signal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Passenger Side J/B
B
9
4M
Body ECU
3
4H
R
14
B12 PKB
1
P3
Parking Brake SW
E74085
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1788
05-1599
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PARKING BRAKE SWITCH CIRCUIT)
Disconnect the B12 connector from the multiplex network body ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B12-14 - Body ground
Shaft of parking brake switch is pressed
B12-14 - Body ground
Shaft of parking brake switch is not pressed
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B12
B12-14
E74263
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1789
05-1600
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSY
(a)
(b)
ON
OFF
Remove the parking brake switch.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 - Switch body
OFF
(When shaft is pressed)
10 kΩ or higher
1 - Switch body
ON
(When shaft is not
pressed)
Below 1 Ω
E71372
NG
REPLACE PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (PARKING BRAKE SWITCH CIRCUIT)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1790
05-1574
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQA-01
TAIL RELAY CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multiplex network body ECU controls the TAIL relay when a signal is received from the headlamp dimmer switch assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1764
05-1575
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B
Body ECU
TAILLIGHT Relay
1
1
1A
B
4
1J
2
TAIL
4
1B
3
5
4
1H
W
11
1B
8
IA1
J12
J/C
W-B
BR
E
TRLY
F3
Front Parking Lamp LH
G
W-B
1
2
F4
Front Parking Lamp RH
G
W-B
1
2
R8 Taillamp RH
(Rear Combination Lamp RH)
J13
J/C
7
B9
SB
4
B
6
R7 Taillamp LH
(Rear Combination Lamp LH)
BR
W-B
BR
E
E
4
6
B
B
B
W
2
BG2
BR
E
E
E
R15
Rear Side Marker Lamp RH
BR
W-B
1
2
R14
Rear Side Marker Lamp LH
BR
W-B
2
1
W-B
L1
License Plate Lamp
1
W-B
F7
FL Block
2
A
2
Battery
ALT
FL MAIN
1
A
J14
J/C
J3
J/C
BE
BC
A
J1
J/C
EA
EG
W
E74078
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1765
05-1576
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and turn the hand-held tester main switch on.
(c) Select the item below in the ACTIVE TEST and then check the relay operation.
BODY NO.1 (MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU):
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
TAIL LIGHT
Taillamp relay ON/OFF
-
OK: Taillamp comes on.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1766
05-1577
DIAGNOSTICS
2
(a)
(b)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
Disconnect the B9 connector from the multiplex network body ECU.
Using a service wire, connect B9-7 of the wire harness side and body ground.
OK: Taillamp comes on.
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B9
B9-7
E74263
NG
Go to step 3
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1767
05-1578
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSY
(a)
Instrument Panel Junction Block
Front Side View:
(b)
Disconnect the 1J connector from the instrument panel
junction block assy.
Using a service wire, connect 1J-4 of the instrument panel junction block side and body ground.
OK: Taillamp comes on.
1J
1J-4
E72975
NG
Go to step 4
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSY - MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1768
05-1579
DIAGNOSTICS
4
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSY
(a)
Instrument Panel Junction Block
Back Side View:
1B
1B-4
-
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1B-4 - Body ground
Connect 1J-4 and
body ground
10 to 14 V
1B-1 1 - Body ground
Connect 1J-4 and
body ground
10 to 14 V
1H-4 - Body ground
Connect 1J-4 and
body ground
10 to 14 V
1H
1H-4
1B-1 1
E72976
NG
Go to step 5
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (EACH OF TAILLAMP CIRCUIT)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1769
05-1580
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSY
(a)
Instrument panel Junction Block
Front Side View:
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1J-4 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
1J
1J-4
NG
Go to step 6
E72975
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1770
05-1581
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT)
(a)
Instrument Panel Junction Block
Back Side View:
(b)
Disconnect the 1A connector from the instrument panel
junction block assy.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1A-1 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
1A
1A-1
E72976
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1771
05-1537
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQ2-01
CUSTOMIZE PARAMETERS
HINT:
The followings are the possible items to be customized.
NOTICE:
After confirming whether the items of the customer’s request are applicable or not for the customized items, perform the customize operation.
Be sure to record the current value before customizing.
In case of performing the troubleshooting, pay attention as there is a possibility that the function is OFF by customizing. (Example: In case of the symptom in which ”The wireless operation
does not function”, check that the wireless operation is not OFF by customizing, then perform
the troubleshooting.)
ILLUMINATED ENTRY
DISPLAY(ITEM)
DEFAULT
CONTENTS
SETTING
I/L ON / UNLOCK
(Interior lamp ON w/ door
key unlock)
ON
Function to light up the interior lamp*, ignition lamp and step
lamp when unlocking with the door key cylinder.
*: Interior lamp comes on when the interior lamp switch is at
the DOOR position.
LIGHTING TIME
(Lighting Time)
15 s
To change the lighting time after closing the door. (It will
quickly fade out in case of turning the ignition ON.)
ON / OFF
7.5 s / 15 s / 30 s
LIGHT CONTROL
HINT:
Sensitivity adjustment can hardly be confirmed. Please check by customer’s actual driving.
DISPLAY(ITEM)
DEFAULT
SENSITIVITY
(Turn ON luminous
intensity)
NORMAL
LIGHT CTRL TYPE
(Control Type)
CURRENT
CONTENTS
SETTING
DARK2 / DARK1 / NORMAL
/ LIGHT1 / LIGHT2
To adjust the sensitivity of the lighting illumination.
Refer to the *1 illustration.
To change the control logic when the light control switch is in
the AUTO position. Refer to the *2 illustration.
CURRENT / OLD
Illustration of *1
Dark
Lighting brightness
DARK2
Setting
Bright
DARK1
NORMAL
LIGHT1
LIGHT2
Illustration of *2
Brightness of the surrounding when lighting
OLD
CURRENT
Lighting delay
Delay of turning light off
Old logic
6 sec.
6 sec.
3 sec.
New logic **1
(’97/8-)
15 sec.
15 sec.
15 sec.
**2
**1: The new one has the logic to light up two times brighter than the old logic.
**2: Delay time until the headlamp is turned on when it suddenly gets dark.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1727
05-1544
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQ4-01
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
D3
BAT
SIL
SG
1.
(a)
DLC3
CG
CHECK DLC3
The vehicle’s ECU uses BEAN conforming to ISO 9141-2
for communication.
The terminal arrangement of DLC3 complies with SAE
J1962 and matches the ISO 9141-2 format.
C52361
Standard:
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus ”+” line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
HINT:
If the screen displays UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE after you have connected the cable of the
hand-held tester to the DLC3, turned the ignition switch ON and used the hand-held tester, there is a problem on the vehicle side or tester side.
If communication is normal when the tester is connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 of the
original vehicle.
If communication is still impossible when the tester is connected to another vehicle, the problem is
probably in the tester itself, so consult the Service Department listed in the tester’s manual.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1734
05-1546
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQ6-01
DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST
1.
DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the DATA LIST displayed on the hand-held tester, you can read the value of the switch, sensor, actuator, etc. without removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of troubleshooting is one of
the methods to shorten labor time.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) According to the display on the tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
BODY NO.1 (MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU):
Item
Measurement Item/
Display (Range)
I/L ON/UNLOCK
Interior light ON w/unlock/ON or OFF
Customized value will be displayed
-
LIGHTING TIME
Lighting time/
7.5s or 15s or 30s
Customized value will be displayed
-
SENSITIVITY
Turn on luminous intensity/ DARK2 or
DARK1 or NO
Customized value will be displayed
-
LIGHT CTRL TYPE
Light control system/
CURRENT or OLD
Customized value will be displayed
-
PARKING BRAKE SW
Parking brake SW
signal/ON or OFF
ON: Parking brake switch is ON
OFF: Parking brake switch is released
-
LUGG COURTSY SW
Luggage door courtesy switch/ ON or OFF
ON: Luggage door is open
OFF: Luggage door is closed
-
F FOG LIGHT SW
Front fog light SW
signal/ON or OFF
ON: Front fog light switch is in ON position
OFF: Front fog light switch is in OFF position
-
AUTO LIGHT SW
Auto light SW signal/
ON or OFF
ON: Light control switch is in AUTO position
OFF: Light control switch is in except AUTO position
-
HEAD LIGHT SW
Headlight control SW
signal/ON or OFF
ON: Light control switch is in HEAD position
OFF: Light control switch is in except HEAD position
-
TAIL LIGHT SW
Tail light SW signal/
ON or OFF
ON: Light control switch is in TAIL or HEAD position
OFF: Light control switch is in OFF position
-
ILLUMINATE RATE
Illumination rate information
Condition value will be displayed
-
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
2.
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator, etc. to operate
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one of the
methods to shorten labor time. The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) According to the display on the tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
BODY NO.1 (MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU):
Item
HEAD LIGHT
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
Turn Headlight relay ON/OFF
-
TAIL LIGHT
Turn Tail light relay ON/OFF
-
DIMMER SIG
Turn Dimmer relay ON/OFF
-
(Test Details)
Turn Interior light and Key illumination ON/OFF
(Vehicle Condition)
Interior light SW is in DOOR position and all
doors are closed
-
ILLUMI OUTPUT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1736
05-1601
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05CS4-05
DOOR COURTESY SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multiplex network body ECU detects the condition of the door courtesy switch assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Body ECU
J13
J/C
W
14
IA1
LG
15
B12 RCTY
V
17
IO2
SB
16
B12 PCTY
B
9
IA1
B
11
B11 DCTY
W
B
B
B
W
6 BH1
G
1
1
D9
Door Courtesy SW
Rear LH
1
D10
Door Courtesy SW
Rear RH
1
D8
Door Courtesy SW
Front RH
D7
Door Courtesy SW
Front LH
E74081
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1791
05-1602
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(COURTESY LAMP SWITCH - MULTIPLEX
NETWORK BODY ECU)
Disconnect the B11 and B12 connectors from the multiplex network body ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B11-1 1 - Body ground
Driver side door is open.
Driver side door is closed.
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
B12-16 - Body ground
Front passenger side door is open.
Front passenger side door is closed.
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
B12-15 - Body ground
One of the rear side doors is open.
Both rear side doors are closed.
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B12
B12-16
B12-15
B11
B11-1 1
E74263
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1792
05-1603
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT COURTESY LAMP SWITCH
ON
OFF
(a)
(b)
Remove the courtesy lamp switch.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 - Body ground
OFF
(When shaft is pressed)
10 kΩ or higher
1 - Body ground
ON
(When shaft is not
pressed)
Below 1 Ω
E71371
NG
REPLACE COURTESY LAMP SWITCH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (EACH OF COURTESY SWITCH CIRCUIT)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1793
05-1545
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQ5-01
DTC CHECK/CLEAR
1.
DTC CHECK
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Read DTCs by following the prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
Please refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
2.
DTC CLEAR
(a) DTC can be erased by operating the hand-held tester.
HINT:
Please refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1735
05-1606
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQG-02
ILLUMINATION CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multiplex network body ECU controls the following.
(1) Key cylinder lamp
(2) Interior lamp
(3) Personal lamp (overhead J/B)
(4) Door courtesy lamp
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1796
05-1607
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
D6
Door Courtesy Lamp Front RH
3
IN1
BR
G
1
8
IL1
Y
3
IB1
V
I14
Ignition Key Cylinder Illumination
Y (*2)
10
IN2
Y (*1)
1
OFF
ON
G
1
4H
W-B
8
IE1
W-B
5
4D
W
1
IE1
3
W
O5
Overhead J/B
7 CTY
+B1
5
4J
5
IE1
R
R
2
DOOR
2
4F
BR
11
B12 ILE
7
4L
1
4N
13
4D
12
4D
B
W
W-B
W-B
6
4H
V
Engine Room J/B
D.C.C
DOME
3
2A
Instrument Panel J/B
12
1D
19
B11 DCYL
12
1
2I
6
1K
L
Passenger Side J/B
G (*1)
6
2
R
I16
Interior Lamp
Y
O
2 D5
Door Courtesy Lamp Front LH
10
G
O
IB2
1
2
G (*2)
1 T7 Ignition Key Cylinder Illumination
(Transponder Key Amplifier)
2
Body ECU
12
B12 PCYL
P FR DOOR
12
IK3
R
F7
FL Block
W
3
D FR DOOR
Battery
1
1A
FL MAIN
ALT
B
2
1
IC
W
*1: w/ Engine Immobilizer System
*2: w/o Engine Immobilizer System
E74086
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1797
05-1608
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(ILLUMINATION CIRCUIT)
Disconnect the B11 and B12 connectors from the multiplex network body ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B11-19 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
B12-11 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
B12-12 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B11
B12
B12-12
B12-1 1
B11-19
E74263
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1798
05-1609
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT INTERIOR LIGHT
(a)
Connector Front View:
I16
Inspect room lamp assy No.1 (interior light).
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified resistance
1-2
Switch is OFF
Below 1 Ω
1-3
Switch is OFF
Below 1 Ω
(2)
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 1 and negative (-) lead to terminal 2, then
check that the lamp comes on when the switch is in
the DOOR position.
OK: Lamp comes on.
(3) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 1 and negative (-) lead to terminal 3, then
check that the lamp comes on when the switch is in
the ON position.
OK: Lamp comes on.
E69434
E50228
(b)
Connector Front View:
T7
Inspect key cylinder illumination.
(1) w/ Theft deterrent system:
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 2 and negative (-) lead to terminal 6, then
check that the lamp comes on.
OK: Illumination comes on.
E74066
(2)
w/o Theft deterrent system:
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 2 and negative (-) lead to terminal 1, then
check that the lamp comes on.
OK: Illumination comes on.
Connector Front View:
I14
E69342
(c)
Connector Front View:
O5
Inspect personal lamp (overhead J/B).
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 12 and negative (-) lead to terminal 7, then
check that the lamp comes on when switch is in the
DOOR position.
OK: Lamp comes on.
E72986
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1799
05-1610
DIAGNOSTICS
(d)
Connector Front View:
D5
D6
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
Inspect courtesy lamp.
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 1 and negative (-) lead to terminal 2, then
check that the lamp comes on.
OK: Lamp comes on.
NG
REPLACE INTERIOR LIGHT (EACH OF ILLUMINATION LAMP)
E69342
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (EACH OF ILLUMINATION CIRCUIT)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1800
05-1594
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQE-01
IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit detects the state of the ignition switch and sends it to the multiplex network body ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B
I15
Ignition SW
2
L
1C
ACC 3
IG1
10
1K
1C
IG1 4
AM1
6
1C
W
6
1J
7
G
2 AM1
RAD No.2
Body ECU
Center J/B
6
W
8
3A
3C
GR
10
3A
5
3B
B
BR
17
B9 ACC
5
B9 IG
1
1A
2
1
F7
FL Block
W
B
1
ALT
2
FL MAIN
Battery
E74083
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1784
05-1595
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Inspect if another system (engine, wiper and so on) is normal before performing this procedure.
1
(a)
(b)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUIT)
Disconnect the B9 connector from multiplex network body ECU.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B9-5 - Body ground
Ignition switch is ON
Ignition switch is OFF
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
B9-17 - Body ground
Ignition switch is ACC
Ignition switch is OFF
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B9
B9-5
B9-17
E74263
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR (IGNITION SWITCH - MULTIPLEX
NETWORK BODY ECU)
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1785
05-1586
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQC-01
LIGHT CONTROL SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit detects the state of the headlamp dimmer switch.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Body ECU
10
B10 FFOG
BR
Passenger Side J/B
2
4N
Y
6
4F
14
B10 HU
15
Y
O
B10
18
B10
17
B10
16
B10
V
LG
P
C13
Combination Switch
11 7
LFG BFG HU
Fog
Light SW
14 13
8
HL
HF
T
H
HF
TAIL
HEAD
A
12
EL
A
OFF
ON
OFF
TAIL
Light
Control SW HEAD
AUTO
LOW
Dimmer SW HIGH
FLASH
17
10
16
W-B
L
IA
E74080
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1776
05-1587
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
INSPECT MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
Disconnect the B10 connector from the multiplex network body ECU.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B10-10 - Body ground
Front fog light switch OFF → ON
10 kΩ or higher → Below 1 Ω
B10-14 - Body ground
Headlamp Dimmer switch LOW → HIGH
10 kΩ or higher → Below 1 Ω
B10-15 - Body ground
Headlamp Dimmer switch LOW → FLASH
10 kΩ or higher → Below 1 Ω
B10-16 - Body ground
Light control switch OFF → AUTO
10 kΩ or higher → Below 1 Ω
B10-17 - Body ground
Light control switch OFF → HEAD
10 kΩ or higher → Below 1 Ω
B10-18 - Body ground
Light control switch OFF → TAIL
10 kΩ or higher → Below 1 Ω
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B10
B10-10
B10-14
B10-18
B10-15
B10-17 B10-16
NG
E74263
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1777
05-1588
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT HEADLAMP DIMMER SWITCH ASSY
(a)
Connector Front View:
C13
Inspect light control switch (when headlamp is malfunctioning).
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
12 - 16
13 - 16
14 - 16
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
14 - 16
TAIL
Below 1 Ω
13 - 16
14 - 16
HEAD
Below 1 Ω
12 - 16
AUTO
Below 1 Ω
E11948
(b)
Inspect headlamp dimmer switch (when headlamp is malfunctioning).
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
(c)
Condition
Specified condition
16 - 17
LOW
Below 1 Ω
7 - 16
HIGH
Below 1 Ω
7 - 16
8 - 16
FLASH
Below 1 Ω
Inspect front fog light switch (when fog lamp is malfunctioning).
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
10 - 11
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
10 - 11
ON
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE HEADLAMP DIMMER SWITCH ASSY
(SEE PAGE 65-25 )
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1778
05-1556
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQ9-01
HEADLIGHT RELAY CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multiplex network body ECU controls the HEAD relay when a signal is received from the headlamp dimmer switch assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room J/B
1
2I
MAIN
1
Body ECU
HEAD LAMP Relay
1
2B
2 4
3
1
2G
1
2
4
IK3
L-R
R
3
B11 HRLY
R-B
Engine Room R/B
H-LP RH LWR
2
2
2
1
H-LP LH LWR
2
2
1
R-W
H2
Headlamp LH (Low)
2
W-B
1
H4
Headlamp RH (Low)
R-Y
W-B
2
1
F7
FL Block
W
W
3
FL MAIN
Battery
1
A
J3
J/C
A
EA
E74076
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1746
05-1557
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and turn the hand-held tester main switch on.
(c) Select the item below in the ACTIVE TEST and then check the relay operation.
BODY NO.1 (MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU):
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
HEAD LIGHT
Headlamp relay ON/OFF
-
OK: Headlamp comes on.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2
(a)
(b)
INSPECT MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
Disconnect the B11 connector from the multiplex network body ECU.
Using a service wire, connect B11-3 of the wire harness side and body ground.
OK: Headlamp comes on.
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B11
B11-3
E74263
NG
Go to step 3
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1747
05-1558
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
(b)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT ENGINE ROOM J/B
Disconnect the 2B connector from the engine room J/B.
Using a service wire, connect 2B-1 of the engine room J/B side and body ground.
OK: Headlamp comes on.
Engine Room J/B
Connector Front View:
2B-1
2B
E72974
NG
Go to step 4
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (ENGINE ROOM J/B - MULTIPLEX NETWORK
BODY ECU)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1748
05-1559
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT ENGINE ROOM J/B
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2G-1 - Body ground
Connect 2B-1 and body ground
10 to 14 V
Engine Room J/B
Connector Front View:
2G
2G-1
E72974
NG
Go to step 5
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (EACH OF HEADLAMP CIRCUIT)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1749
05-1560
DIAGNOSTICS
5
(a)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT ENGINE ROOM J/B
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2B-1 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
Engine Room J/B
Connector Front View:
2B-1
2B
E72974
NG
Go to step 6
OK
REPLACE ENGINE ROOM J/B
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1750
05-1561
DIAGNOSTICS
6
(a)
(b)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT)
Disconnect the 2I connector from the engine room J/B.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2I-1 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
Engine Room J/B
Connector Front View:
2I
2I-1
E72974
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE ENGINE ROOM J/B
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1751
05-1582
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQB-01
FRONT FOG LIGHT CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multiplex network body ECU controls the FOG relay when a signal is received from the headlamp dimmer switch assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B
Body ECU
TAILLIGHT Relay
1
B
1
1A
2
TAIL
5
4
1J
3
FOG LIGHT Relay
2
1
FR FOG
2
3
5
1J
7
SB
7
B9 TRLY
V
6
B9 FFGO
R-W
1B
F2
Front Fog Lamp RH
R-W
1
2
W-B
F1
Front Fog Lamp LH
W-B
R-W
1
2
F7
FL Block
W
2
ALT
1
FL MAIN
A
J1
J/C
Battery
A
J3
J/C
EG
EA
E74079
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1772
05-1583
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Inspect if the taillamp system is normal before performing this procedure.
1
(a)
(b)
INSPECT MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
Disconnect the B9 connector from the multiplex network body ECU.
Using a service wire, connect B9-6 and B9-7 of the wire harness side and body ground.
OK: Front fog lamp comes on.
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B9
B9-7
B9-6
E74263
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1773
05-1584
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSY
(a)
Instrument Panel Junction Block
Front Side View:
(b)
Disconnect the 1J connector from the instrument panel
junction block.
Using a service wire, connect 1J-2, 1J-4 of the instrument panel junction block side and body ground.
OK: Front fog lamp comes on.
1J
1J-2
1J-4
E72975
NG
Go to step 3
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSY - MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1774
05-1585
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK ASSY
(a)
Instrument Panel Junction Block
Back Side View:
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1B-7 - Body ground
Connect 1J-2, 1J-4
and body ground
10 to 14 V
1B
1B-7
E72977
NG
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION
BLOCK ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR (EACH OF FOG LAMP CIRCUIT)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1775
05-1589
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQD-01
AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multiplex network body ECU receives a signal from the automatic light control sensor.
HINT:
A DTC code is output when the automatic light control sensor is malfunctioning or there is an open or short
circuit in the automatic light control sensor (see page 05-1551 ).
WIRING DIAGRAM
A23
Automatic Light Control Sensor
CLTS
CLTE
Body ECU
R
21
B9
CLTS
W
20
B9
CLTE
4
3
12
CLTB
G
B9
1
CLTB
E68822
E70389
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1779
05-1590
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness View:
A23 Automatic Light Control Sensor
3
Disconnect the automatic light control sensor connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A23-1 - A23-3
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
1
I39976
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR)
(a)
Wire Harness View:
A23 Automatic Light Control Sensor
(b)
4
Disconnect the B9 connector from the multiplex network
body ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A23-4 - B9-21
Always
Below 1 Ω
I39976
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B9
B9-21
E74263
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1780
05-1591
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
REPLACE AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
OK: Return to normal condition.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
OK
END
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR)
(a)
Wire Harness View:
A23 Automatic Light Control Sensor
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A23-1 - Body ground
Ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
1
I39976
NG
Go to step 6
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1781
05-1592
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR)
(a)
Wire Harness View:
A23 Automatic Light Control Sensor
(b)
3
Disconnect the B9 connector from the multiplex network
body ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A23-3 - B9-20
Always
Below 1 Ω
I39976
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B9
B9-20
E74263
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1782
05-1593
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR)
(a)
Wire Harness View:
A23 Automatic Light Control Sensor
(b)
1
Disconnect the B9 connector from the multiplex network
body ECU.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A23-1 - B9-12
Always
Below 1 Ω
I39976
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Connector Front View:
B9
B9-12
E74263
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1783
05-1536
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05ETG-02
OPERATION CHECK
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
ILLUMINATED ENTRY SYSTEM OPERATION CHECK
Illuminated entry system controls the following lamps:
Ignition key cylinder lamp
Interior lamp (Room lamp assy No.1)
Personal lamp (Overhead J/B)
Check that the lamps come on after:
(1) Unlocking any door that was closed and locked with the ignition switch off.
Check that the lamps fade out after:
(1) Leaving the doors unlocked for 15 seconds
(2) Turning the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position
(3) Locking all the doors
Check that the lamps stay ON for at least 15 seconds after opening any of the doors, then fade out
again after 15 seconds.
Check that the lamps fade out after:
(1) Leaving the doors unlocked for 15 seconds
(2) Locking all the doors
Check that the lamps stay ON for at least 15 seconds after opening any of the doors, then fade out
again in 15 seconds after closing all the doors.
Check that the lamps come on when opening any of the doors or turning the ignition switch off from
the ACC or ON position.
LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF OPERATION CHECK
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and switch the headlamps into the TAIL or HEAD position.
Turn the ignition switch off and open the driver’s door, and check that the headlamps go off immediately.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and switch the headlamps into the AUTO position.
Turn the ignition switch off and open the driver’s door when operating the automatic light control system, and check that the headlamps go off immediately.
AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL OPERATION CHECK
3.
HINT:
Perform the operation check at a location with bright surroundings.
(a) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(b) Turn the headlamp dimmer switch to the AUTO position.
(c) Cover the automatic light control sensor and check that the taillamp and headlamp in order.
(d) Uncover the automatic light control sensor and check that the headlamp and taillamp go off in order.
4.
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT OPERATION CHECK
(a) Check that the high beams come on when the headlamp switch is off with the engine running and parking brake released.
(b) Check that the high beams go off when turning the headlamp dimmer switch into the TAIL or HEAD
(LOW) position under the condition as shown in (a).
(c) Check that the high beams go off when turning the ignition switch off under the condition as shown
in (a).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1726
05-1531
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05ETF-02
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
LIGHTING SYSTEM
Illumination control system (Illuminated entry system):
When a door is unlocked through a key or transmitter operation, or if a door is opened or closed, the
illuminated entry system turns on the interior lamp and the ignition key illumination.
(1) The multiplex network body ECU receives the following.
Door courtesy switch signal
Door detection switch signal
Ignition switch signal
(2) The multiplex network body ECU controls the following based on the signals listed in (1).
Illumination operation signal
(3) The multiplex network body ECU controls the on/off and fade-in/fade-out operation of the following.
Room lamp assy No.1
Ignition key cylinder lamp
Personal lamp (Overhead J/B)
Manual light control system:
This system functions if lights such as the headlamps and taillamps come on by manual operation of
the light control switch.
(1) The multiplex network body ECU receives the following.
Light control switch signal
Fog lamp switch signal
(2) The multiplex network body ECU controls the following based on the signals listed in (1).
HEAD relay operation signal
TAIL relay operation signal
FOG relay operation signal
DRL relay No.2
DRL relay No.3
DRL relay No.4
(3) The multiplex network body ECU controls the on/off operation of the following signals based on
the signals listed in (2).
Headlamp (Low)
Clearance lamp
Taillamp
License plate lamp
Fog lamp
Light auto turn off system:
When the headlamps and taillamps are on through the operation of the automatic light control system
or through the light control switch, if the ignition switch is turned off and driver side door is opened, this
system will turn the headlamps and taillamps off immediately.
(1) The multiplex network body ECU receives the following.
Door courtesy switch signal
Ignition switch signal
(2) The multiplex network body ECU controls the following based on the signals listed in (1).
HEAD relay operation signal
TAIL relay operation signal
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1721
05-1532
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
(3)
(d)
(e)
The multiplex network body ECU controls the illuminating period based on the signals listed in
(2).
Headlamp (Low)
Headlamp (Hi)
Clearance lamp
Taillamp
License plate lamp
Fog lamp
Automatic light control system:
When the light control switch is in the AUTO position, the automatic light control sensor detects ambient light and automatically turns the headlamps and taillamps on or off accordingly.
(1) The multiplex network body ECU receives the following.
Light control switch signal
Automatic light control sensor signal
(2) The multiplex network body ECU controls the following based on the signals listed in (1).
HEAD relay operation signal
TAIL relay operation signal
(3) The multiplex network body ECU controls the on/off operation of the following.
Headlamp (Low)
Clearance lamp
Taillamp
License plate lamp
Daytime running light system:
This system is directly connected to the high-beam headlamps and is designed to automatically activate the daytime running light in order to remain highly visible to other vehicles.
(1) The multiplex network body ECU receives the following.
Ignition switch signal
Generator signal
Parking brake switch signal
Light control switch signal
(2) The multiplex network body ECU controls the following based on the signals listed in (1).
DRL relay operation signal
(3) The multiplex network body ECU controls the on/off operation of the following.
Headlamp (Hi)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1722
05-1530
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05ETD-02
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Ignition Switch
Multiplex Network Body ECU
Alternator L Signal
Driver Side Door Detection Signal
Headlamp Dimmer Switch
Courtesy Lamp Switch
Door Unlock Detection Switch
Parking Brake Switch
Automatic Light Control Sensor
Headlamp (Low)
HEAD Relay
Taillamp
TAIL Relay
Headlamp (Hi)
DRL Relay
Fog Lamp
FOG Relay
Door Courtesy Lamp
Illumination
Ignition Key Cylinder Lamp
Interior Lamp
Generator
ECM
Alternator L Signal
Power Window Master Switch
Driver Side Door Detection Signal
BEAN
BEAN
DLC3
: Input Signal
: Output Signal
E70394
E74056
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1720
05-1535
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05CTX-05
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
LIGHTING SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
VIN
Customer’s Name
Production Date
Licence Plate No.
Date Vehicle
Brought in
/
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Frequency Problem Occurs
Weather Conditions Weather
When Problem
Occurred
Outdoor Temperature
km
mile
Odometer Reading
/
Always
Once only
/
Sometimes (
Fine
Cloudy
Various/ Others
Rainy
times per
day, month)
Snowy
Hot
Warm
Cool
Cold (Approx. °F ( °C))
Headlamp system
Taillight system
Automatic light control system
Malfunctioning
System:
Light auto turn off system
Daytime running light system
Fog light system
Turn signal and hazard warning system
Stop light system
Back-up light system
Illuminated entry system
Others
I34763
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1725
05-1547
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05CTZ-05
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
1.
DTC CHECK
If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check, check the suspected area listed for that code in the table
below, and proceed to the appropriate page.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Symptom
Suspected Area
B1241
(05-1548 )
Body ECU switch circuit diagnosis
Headlamp dimmer switch assy
Wire harness or connector
Multiplex network body ECU
B1244
(05-1551 )
Light sensor circuit malfunction
Automatic light control sensor
Wire harness or connector
Multiplex network body ECU
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1737
05-1533
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05CUG-05
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
The hand-held tester can be used at steps 4, 5, 6 and 13.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORK SHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS (SEE PAGE 05-1535 )
(a)
Confirm problem symptoms.
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
SYMPTOM DOES NOT OCCUR (GO TO STEP 4)
SYMPTOM OCCURS (GO TO STEP 5)
4
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
5
CHECK BODY MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 05-2040 )
(a)
Check for the DTC output.
MULTIPLEX DTC OUTPUT (PROCEED TO
”BODY MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM”)
NO MULTIPLEX DTC (GO TO STEP 6)
6
DTC CHECK (SEE PAGE 05-1545 )
MALFUNCTION CODE (GO TO STEP 7)
NORMAL SYSTEM CODE (GO TO STEP 8)
7
DTC CHART (SEE PAGE 05-1547 )
GO TO STEP 10
8
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (SEE PAGE 05-1538 )
9
TERMINALS OF ECU (SEE PAGE 05-1541 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1723
05-1534
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
10
CIRCUIT INSPECTION (SEE PAGE 05-1548 TO 05-1606 )
11
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
12
REPAIR OR REPLACE
13
CONFIRMATION TEST
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1724
05-1527
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05ETC-02
LOCATION
Engine Room R/B No.3
DRL Fuse
DRL No.2 Relay
DRL No.3 Relay
DRL No.4 Relay
Headlamp Assy RH
Headlamp (Low)
Headlamp (High)
Parking Lamp
Turn Signal Lamp
Generator Assy
Engine Room J/B
H-LP LH UPR Fuse
H-LP RH UPR Fuse
HAZARD Fuse
TOWING Fuse
DOME Fuse
HEAD LAMP Relay
Engine Room R/B
H-LP LH LWR Fuse
H-LP RH LWR Fuse
Front Fog Lamp RH
Front Fog Lamp LH
Headlamp Assy LH
Headlamp (Low)
Headlamp (High)
Parking Lamp
Turn Signal Lamp
I40003
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1717
05-1528
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
Front Door w/ Motor Lock Assy LH
(Door Unlock Detection Switch LH)
Vanity Lamp Assy LH
Overhead J/B (Personal Lamp)
Vanity Lamp Assy RH
Room Lamp Assy No.1 (Interior Lamp)
Front Door w/ Motor Lock Assy RH
(Door Unlock Detection Switch RH)
Power Window Master
Switch with ECU
Front Door Courtesy Lamp Switch
Front Door Courtesy
Lamp Switch Assy
Room Lamp Assy No.2
(Rear Interior Lamp)
High Mounted Stop Lamp
Rear Door w/ Motor Lock Assy RH
(Door Unlock Detection Switch RH)
Rear Door Courtesy
Lamp Switch Assy
Front Door
Courtesy Lamp Assy
Rear Door w/ Motor
Lock Assy LH
(Door Unlock Detection Switch LH)
Rear Door Courtesy
Lamp Switch Assy
License Plate Lamp
Front Door Courtesy
Lamp Assy
Back Door Lock Assy
(Back Door Courtesy
Lamp Switch)
Rear Combination Lamp LH
Stop Lamp
Taillamp
Turn Signal Lamp
Back-up Lamp
Rear Side Marker Lamp
Rear Combination Lamp RH
Stop Lamp
Taillamp
Turn Signal Lamp
Back-up Lamp
Rear Side Marker Lamp
I40005
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1718
05-1529
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
Automatic Light Control Sensor
Combination Meter Assy
High Beam Indicator Lamp
Hazard Warning Switch Assy
Multiplex Network
Body ECU
Parking Brake
Switch
ECM
Glove Box Lamp
Key Cylinder Lamp
Headlamp Dimmer Switch Assy
Light Control Switch
Headlamp Dimmer Switch
Turn Signal Lamp Switch
Front Fog Lamp Switch
Instrument Panel Junction Block
FR FOG Fuse
STOP Fuse
TAIL Fuse
TAIL LIGHT Relay
FOG LIGHT Relay
Stop Lamp Switch
DLC3
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
I40007
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1719
05-1526
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05CTV-05
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
PRECAUTION OF HEADLAMP BULB REPLACEMENT
If even a thin film of oil is left on the surface of the halogen lamp, the bulb may be damaged because
the lamp will burn at a higher temperature.
Handle any halogen lamp with great care. Dropping, hitting or damaging the bulb, in any way, may
result in it exploding and shattering because the internal pressure is high.
Always prepare a new bulb for immediate replacement. While replacing the bulb, the lens may attract
dust and moisture if removed from the vehicle for too long.
Always use a bulb of the same wattage for replacement.
Firmly reinstall the socket after bulb replacement. The lens may become cloudy or the light cavity may
fill with water through the gaps around the socket.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1716
05-1538
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05CU2-05
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
If a normal system code is displayed during the DTC check but the problem still occurs, check the circuits
for each problem symptom in the order given in the table below and proceed to the relevant troubleshooting
page.
HINT:
Inspect the fuse and relay before confirming the suspected area as shown in the charts below.
Inspect each malfunction circuit in numerical order for the corresponding symptom.
If the malfunction still exists even after checking and confirming that all the circuits are normal, replace the
ECU.
1.
HEADLAMP AND TAIL LAMP SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected Area
”Low beam” does not come on (One side).
3. Bulb
4. Wire harness or connector
”Low beam” does not come on (Both sides).
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
”High beam” does not come on (One side).
1. Bulb
2. Wire harness or connector
”High beam” does not come on (Both sides).
(Low beam is normal)
1.
1.
2.
3.
”Flash” does not come on.
(Low beam and High beam are normal)
1. Light control switch circuit
2. Multiplex network body ECU
Headlamp is dark.
1. Bulb
2. Wire harness or connector
Tail lamp does not come on (All).
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Only one tail lamp comes on.
1. Bulb
2. Wire harness or connector
Daytime running light system does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Light control switch circuit
Generator signal circuit
Parking brake switch circuit
Ignition switch circuit
DRL relay circuit
Multiplex network body ECU
1.
2.
3.
4.
Light control switch circuit
Ignition switch circuit
Automatic light control sensor circuit
Multiplex network body ECU
2.
See page
-
Bulb
Light control switch circuit
Headlight relay circuit (w/o Daytime running light)
DRL relay circuit (w/ Daytime running light)
Multiplex network body ECU
05-1586
05-1556
05-1562
-
Bulb
Light control switch circuit
DRL relay circuit (w/ Daytime running light)
Multiplex network body ECU
05-1586
05-1562
05-1586
-
Light control switch circuit
TAIL relay circuit
Ignition switch circuit
Door courtesy switch circuit
Multiplex network body ECU
05-1586
05-1574
05-1594
05-1601
05-1586
05-1596
05-1598
05-1594
05-1562
-
AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
Automatic light control system does not operate.
Suspected Area
See page
05-1586
05-1594
05-1589
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1728
05-1539
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF SYSTEM
Symptom
Light auto turn off system does not operate.
4.
Suspected Area
1.
2.
3.
4.
05-1586
05-1594
05-1601
-
FOG LAMP SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected Area
Front fog lamp does not come on with light control switch in the
TAIL or HEAD position.
1. Light control switch circuit
2. Front fog light circuit
3. Multiplex network body ECU
Only one front fog lamp does not come on.
1. Bulb
2. Wire harness or connector
5.
See page
Light control switch circuit
Ignition switch circuit
Door courtesy switch circuit
Multiplex network body ECU
See page
05-1586
05-1582
-
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected Area
See page
”Hazard” and ”Turn” do not come on.
1. Ignition switch
2. Turn signal flasher relay
3. Wire harness or connector
65-2
-
Hazard warning light does not come on.
(Turn is normal)
1. Hazard warning switch
2. Wire harness or connector
65-4
-
Turn signal does not come on.
(Hazard is normal)
1. Headlamp dimmer switch (turn signal switch)
2. Wire harness or connector
65-4
-
Turn signal does not come on in one direction.
1. Headlamp dimmer switch (turn signal switch)
2. Wire harness or connector
65-4
-
Only one bulb does not come on.
1. Bulb
2. Wire harness or connector
6.
-
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected Area
See page
Stop light does not operate (All).
1. Stop light switch
2. Wire harness or connector
65-4
-
Only one stop light does not operate.
1. Bulb
2. Wire harness or connector
-
7.
ILLUMINATED ENTRY SYSTEM
Symptom
Illuminated entry of multiplex network body ECU control does not
operate (All).
Suspected Area
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
See page
Ignition switch circuit
Door lock position circuit
Door courtesy switch circuit
Illumination circuit
Multiplex network body ECU
05-1594
05-1604
05-1601
05-1606
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1729
05-1540
DIAGNOSTICS
8.
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
OTHERS
Symptom
Suspected Area
See page
1. Park/neutral position switch
2. Wire harness or connector
05-922 or
05-1036
-
Vanity light does not operate.
1. Bulb
2. Wire harness or connector
-
Door courtesy lamp does not come on.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Luggage compartment light does not come on.
(When back door is opened)
1. Rear interior light
2. Back door courtesy switch
3. Wire harness or connector
Luggage compartment light does not come on.
(When rear door is opened)
1.
2.
3.
4.
Back up lamp does not come on (All).
Bulb
Door courtesy switch circuit
Wire harness or connector
Multiplex network body ECU
05-1601
65-4
65-4
-
Rear interior light
Door courtesy switch circuit
Wire harness or connector
Multiplex network body ECU
65-4
05-1601
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1730
05-1541
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
05IQ3-01
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
B12
B11
B10
B9
E74263
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
GND2 (B9-2) - Body ground
W-B - Body
ground
Body ground
BR - W-B
Ignition switch signal
Condition
Specified Condition
Always
Below 1 V
Ignition switch is OFF
Ignition switch is in the ON position
Below 1 V
10 to 14 V
V - W-B
Front fog relay
(Front fog circuit)
Front fog lamp is in the OFF position
Front fog lamp is in the ON position
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
TRLY (B9-7) - GND1 (B12-7)
SB - W-B
TAIL Relay
(TAIL signal)
Light control switch is in the TAIL
position
Light control switch is in the OFF
position
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
MPX2 (B9-10) GND1 (B12-7)
O - W-B
Multiplex communication
circuit
Ignition switch is in the ON position
Signal waveform
CLTB (B9-12) - GND1 (B12-7)
G - W-B
Automatic light control
sensor
(Power source circuit)
Ignition switch is OFF
Ignition switch is in the ON position
Below 1 V
10 to 14 V
ACC (B9-17) - GND1 (B12-7)
B - W-B
Ignition switch signal
Ignition switch is OFF
Ignition switch is in the ACC position
Below 1 V
10 to 14 V
CLTE (B9-20) - GND1 (B12-7)
W - W-B
Automatic light control
sensor
(Ground circuit)
Always
Below 1 V
CLTS (B9-21) - GND1 (B12-7)
R - W-B
Automatic light control
sensor
(Signal circuit)
Ignition switch is in the ON position
Signal waveform
MPX1 (B10-6) GND1 (B12-7)
W - W-B
Multiplex communication
circuit
Ignition switch is in the ON position
Signal waveform
BR - W-B
Front fog lamp switch
(Front fog lamp signal)
Fog lamp switch is in the OFF
position
Fog lamp switch is in the ON position
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
IG (B9-5) - GND1 (B12-7)
FFGO (B9-6) - GND1 (B12-7)
FFOG (B10-10) GND1 (B12-7)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1731
05-1542
DIAGNOSTICS
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
BR - W-B
Door lock position switch
(Front passenger side
door circuit)
Front passenger side door is in the
unlock position
Front passenger side door is in the
lock position
Below 1 V
10 to 14 V
Y - W-B
Headlamp dimmer switch
(HIGH signal)
Headlamp dimmer switch is in the
LOW position
Headlamp dimmer switch is in the
HIGH or FLASH position
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
O - W-B
Headlamp dimmer switch
(FLASH signal)
Headlamp dimmer switch is in the
LOW position
Headlamp dimmer switch is in the
FLASH position
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
P - W-B
Light control switch
(AUTO signal)
Light control switch is in the OFF
position
Light control switch is in the AUTO
position
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
LG - W-B
Light control switch
(HEAD signal)
Light control switch is in the OFF
position
Light control switch is in the HEAD
position
Below 1 V
10 to 14 V
V - W-B
Light control switch
(TAIL signal)
Light control switch is in the OFF
position
Light control switch is in the TAIL
position
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
B - W-B
DRL Relay
(DRL signal)
Light control switch is in the OFF
or TAIL position
Light control switch is in the HEAD
position
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
R - W-B
HEAD Relay
(HEAD signal)
Light control switch is in the OFF
or TAIL position
Light control switch is in the HEAD
position
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
BCTY (B11-6) - GND1 (B12-7)
G - W-B
Luggage room light
(Illumination signal)
Luggage room light is OFF (When
switch is in the DOOR position)
Luggage room light is ON (When
switch is in the DOOR position)
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
DCTY (B11-1 1) GND1 (B12-7)
B - W-B
Courtesy switch
(Driver side door circuit)
Driver side door is open
Driver side door is closed
Below 1 V
10 to 14 V
DCYL (B11-19) GND1 (B12-7)
L - W-B
Door courtesy light circuit
Driver side courtesy light is OFF
Driver side courtesy light is ON
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
W-B Body ground
Body ground
Always
Below 1 V
G - W-B
Battery
(B+ circuit)
Always
10 to 14 V
BR - W-B
Each of interior light
(Illumination signal)
Interior light is OFF
Interior light is ON
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
Front passenger side courtesy
light is OFF
Front passenger side courtesy
light is ON
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
Parking brake is ON
Parking brake is released
Below 1 V
10 to 14 V
One of the rear doors is open
Rear doors are closed
Below 1 V
10 to 14 V
LSWP (B10-11) GND1 (B12-7)
HU (B10-14) - GND1 (B12-7)
HF (B10-15) - GND1 (B12-7)
A (B10-16) - GND1 (B12-7)
HEAD (B10-17) GND1 (B12-7)
TAIL (B10-18) - GND1 (B12-7)
DRL (B11-2) GND1 (B12-7) (*1)
HRLY (B11-3) - GND1 (B12-7)
GND1 (B12-7) - Body ground
BECU (B12-9) GND1 (B12-7)
ILE (B12-11) - GND1 (B12-7)
PCYL (B12-12) GND1 (B12-7)
Y - W-B
Door courtesy light circuit
PKB (B12-14) - GND1 (B12-7)
R - W-B
Parking brake switch
RCTY (B12-15) GND1 (B12-7)
LG - W-B
Courtesy switch
(Rear door circuit)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1732
05-1543
DIAGNOSTICS
PCTY (B12-16) GND1 (B12-7)
LSWA (B12-17) GND1 (B12-7)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
SB - W-B
Courtesy switch
(Front passenger side
door circuit)
B - W-B
Door lock position switch
(Rear and back door circuit)
Front passenger door is open
Front passenger door is closed
Below 1 V
10 to 14 V
One of the rear and back doors is
in the unlock position
Rear and back doors are in the
lock position
Below 1 V
10 to 14 V
*1: w/ Daytime running light
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1733
05-1832
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISX-02
POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT (RADIO RECEIVER ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to the radio receiver assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center J/B
13
3A
4
3C
V
20
IK3
L-Y
2
IL1
LG
L-B
9
3I
10
3K
GR
L-B
Radio Receiver Assy
11
R4 ACC
1
R4 B
Engine Room J/B
4
2C
RAD No.1
D.C.C
1
2I
W
I15
Ignition SW
Instrument Panel J/B
3
1K
RAD No.2
6
1C
AM1
1
1A
B
1
2
1C
L
BR
3
ACC
AM1
2
20
R4 GND
W
2
F7
FL Block
ALT
2
3
W
1
FL MAIN
IB
Battery
I39184
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2022
05-1833
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY(B, ACC, GND)
(a)
(b)
R4
B
(c)
GND
ACC
I39175
Disconnect the radio receiver assy connector R4.
Measure the resistance according to the value in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Measure the voltage according to the values in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
B - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2023
05-1812
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISL-02
MAP DISC CANNOT BE INSERTED
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MAP DISC
(a)
I38584
Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK: No deformations or cracks appear on the map
disc.
NG
REPLACE THE MAP DISC
OK
2
(a)
CHECK NAVIGATION ECU
Check that the ”PUSH” indicator near the disc slot comes on.
OK: It does not come on.
NG
PRESS THE EJECT SWITCH TO EJECT THE
DISC
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2002
05-1813
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISM-02
VEHICLE POSITION MARK DEVIATES GREATLY
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK THE GPS MARK
(a)
I39094
Check that the GPS mark is displayed.
OK:The GPS mark is displayed.
NG
GO TO ”GPS MARK IS NOT DISPLAYED” IN THE
FLOW CHART (SEE PAGE 05-1818 )
OK
2
(a)
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE(VEHICLE SENSORS)
Enter the ”Navigation Check” mode (Vehicle Sensors) (see page 05-1765 ).
(b) While driving, compare the ”SPD” indicator to the reading
on the speedometer. Check that these readings are almost the same.
OK: The readings are almost the same.
NG
I38228
GO TO ”SPEED SIGNAL CIRCUIT (NAVIGATION
ECU - COMBINATION METER ASSY)” IN THE
FLOW CHART (SEE PAGE 05-1838 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2003
05-1814
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE(VEHICLE SENSORS)
(a)
Move the shift lever to the R or P position.
Standard:
Shift lever
Display
P
OFF
R
ON
HINT:
The display is updated once per second. As a result, it is normal
for the display to lag behind the actual change in the switch.
I38228
NG
GO TO ”REVERSE SIGNAL CIRCUIT” IN THE
FLOW CHART (SEE PAGE 05-1844 )
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2004
05-1805
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISF-02
BLACK SCREEN (NO IMAGE APPEARS ON NAVIGATION AND
AUDIO SCREEN)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK DISPLAY SETTING
Check that the display is not in ”Screen OFF” mode.
OK: The display setting is not in ”Screen OFF” mode.
NG
CHANGE SCREEN TO ”SCREEN ON” MODE
OK
2
(a)
CHECK IMAGE QUALITY SETTING
Check if screen color quality can be set.
OK: Switching is possible.
OK
PRESS PANEL SWITCH ”DISPLAY” AND SET
SCREEN COLOR QUALITY TO NORMAL
NG
3
CHECK CABIN
(a) Check if condensation is likely to occur, or the temperature is high or low (extremely cold) in the cabin.
HINT:
This problem occurs when the cabin is humid and the temperature rapidly changes. This condition may produce condensation, resulting in a short circuit.
OK: The above condition is not observed.
NG
SET CABIN TEMPERATURE TO APPROPRIATE
DEGREES (20 TO 30C) (68 TO 86F)
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1995
05-1815
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISN-02
CURSOR OR MAP ROTATES WHEN VEHICLE IS STOPPED
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CONDITION
(a)
Check with the customer if the vehicle has been turned by
a turn-table at parking.
OK: The vehicle has not been turned by a turntable.
HINT:
If the ignition switch is turned to the ACC or ON position while
the vehicle is being turned by a turntable, the system may store
the angular velocity at this time. For this reason, the vehicle
position cursor could deviate.
I38146
NG
TURN IGNITION SWITCH TO ON POSITION
WHEN VEHICLE IS COMPLETELY STOPPED
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2005
05-1816
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISO-02
VEHICLE POSITION MARK IS NOT UPDATED
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK THE MAP DISC
(a)
Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK: No deformations or cracks appear on the map
disc.
I38584
NG
REPLACE THE MAP DISC
OK
2
(a)
CHECK THE MAP DISPLAY
Check if a touch scroll can be performed on the map display.
OK: Touch scroll can be performed.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
OK
3
(a)
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE(VEHICLE SENSORS)
Enter the ”Navigation Check” mode (Vehicle Sensors) (see page 05-1765 ).
(b) While driving, compare the ”SPEED” indicator to the reading on the speedometer. Check if these readings are almost the same.
OK: The readings are almost the same.
NG
I38228
GO TO ”SPEED SIGNAL CIRCUIT (NAVIGATION
ECU - COMBINATION METER ASSY)” IN THE
FLOW CHART (SEE PAGE 05-1838 )
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2006
05-1817
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISP-02
CURRENT POSITION DISPLAY DOES NOT APPEAR
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK THE MAP DISC
(a)
I38584
Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK: No deformations or cracks appear on the map
disc.
NG
REPLACE THE MAP DISC
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2007
05-1818
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISQ-02
GPS MARK IS NOT DISPLAYED
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK CABIN
Check the cabin for any object that might interrupt radio reception on the instrument panel. If such an
object exists, remove it and check if the GPS mark appears.
HINT:
GPS works using extremely weak radio waves originating from satellites. If the signal is interrupted by obstructions or another radio wave, the GPS system may not be able to properly receive the signal.
OK: Mark appears.
OK
NORMAL OPERATION
NG
2
(a)
CHECK SURROUNDINGS
Check if the vehicle is in a location where GPS signal reception is bad. If the vehicle is in such a place,
move it elsewhere and check if the GPS mark appears.
HINT:
GPS uses 24 satellites in 6 orbits so that at any time 5 satellites will be in line-of-sight of your vehicle.
GPS signals may not be received, however, depending on surroundings, vehicle direction, and time.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2008
05-1819
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
The following illustrations show some conditions where it may be difficult to receive GPS signals.
In a tunnel
In a building
Forest or tree-lined path
Under an overpass
Between tall buildings
Under a cliff, overhang
I38586
OK: GPS mark is displayed.
OK
RETURNS TO NORMAL
NG
3
(a)
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE(GPS IMFORMATION)
Enter the ”Navigation Check” mode (GPS information) (see page 05-1764 ).
(b) Check how many of the following codes occur in the
”STS” column.
OK: At least 3 codes occur.
OK
I38226
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
(SEE PAGE 67-9 )
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2009
05-1820
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISR-02
VOICE GUIDANCE DOES NOT FUNCTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK NAVIGATION SYSTEM SETTING
(a)
(b)
Enter the ”MENU” screen by pressing the ”MENU” switch.
Enter the volume adjustment screen by pressing the ”Volume” switch.
(c)
Check that ”OFF” is not selected.
OK: OFF is not selected.
I39095
I39096
NG
TURN VOICE GUIDANCE VOLUME UP TO 4
USING VOICE ADJUSTMENT SWITCHES
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2010
05-1821
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK NAVIGATION SETTING
(a)
(b)
Enter the ”MENU” screen by pressing the ”MENU” switch.
Enter the ”Setup” screen by pressing the ”Setup” switch.
(c)
Check that ”Auto Voice Guidance” is not OFF.
OK: Auto voice guidance is not OFF.
Check if ”Voice Guidance in All Modes” is ON.
OK: Voice guidance in all modes is ON.
I39097
(d)
I39854
NG
TURN AUTO VOICE GUIDANCE TO ”ON”
OK
3
CHECK THE MAP DISC
(a)
Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK: No deformations or cracks appear on the map
disc.
I38584
NG
REPLACE THE MAP DISC
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2011
05-1822
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
Check if audio sound can be heard from the driver’s side speaker.
OK: Audio sound can be heard.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
OK
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU (SEE PAGE 67-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2012
05-1823
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISS-02
MAP DISPLAY INCOMPLETE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK THE MAP DISC
(a)
Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK: No deformations or cracks appear on the map
disc.
I38584
NG
REPLACE THE MAP DISC
OK
2
(a)
CHECK THE DISPLAY
Check that displays other than the navigation display are complete.
OK: No other incomplete displays are found.
OK
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
(SEE PAGE 67-9 )
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2013
05-1824
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IST-02
ROUTE CANNOT BE CALCULATED
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK THE MAP DISC
(a)
Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK: No deformations or cracks appear on the map
disc.
I38584
NG
REPLACE THE MAP DISC
OK
2
(a)
SET DESTINATION
Set another destination and check if the system can calculate the route correctly.
OK: Route can be correctly calculated.
OK
NORMAL OPERATION
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2014
05-1825
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISU-02
GYRO ERROR
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE(VEHICLE SENSORS)
Enter the ”Navigation Check” mode (Vehicle Sensors) (see page 05-1765 ).
(b) Check the gyro voltage.
Standard: 0.1 to 4.5 V
I38228
NG
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
(SEE PAGE 67-9 )
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2015
05-1826
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISV-02
MAP DISC READ ERROR
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK THE MAP DISC
(a)
Check for dirt on the map disc surface.
OK: No dirt is on the map disc surface.
HINT:
If dirt is on the map disc surface, wipe it with a soft cloth from
inside to outside in a radial direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use conventional record cleaner or anti-static preservative.
I38583
NG
CLEAN THE MAP DISC
OK
2
CHECK THE MAP DISC
(a)
I38584
Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK: No deformations or cracks appear on the map
disc.
NG
REPLACE THE MAP DISC
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2016
05-1827
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISW-02
SPEED SIGNAL ERROR
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE(VEHICLE SENSORS)
Enter the ”Navigation Check” mode (Vehicle Sensors) (see page 05-1765 ).
(b) While driving, compare the ”SPD” indicator to the reading
on the speedometer. Check if these readings are almost
the same.
OK: The readings are almost the same.
I38228
OK
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
(SEE PAGE 67-9 )
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2017
05-1806
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISG-02
ILLUMINATION FOR PANEL SWITCH DOES NOT COME ON WITH
TAIL SWITCH ON
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
DISPLAY CHECK MODE(VEHICLE SIGNAL CHECK MODE)
Enter the ”Display Check” mode (Vehicle Signal Check Mode) (see page 05-1763 ).
(b) Turn the light control switch TAIL or ON and OFF.
Standard:
TAIL Switch
Display
TAIL or ON
ON
OFF
OFF
HINT:
This display is updated once per second. As a result, it is normal
for the display to lag behind the actual change in the switch.
I38223
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLA Y
(SEE PAGE 67-8 )
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1996
05-1807
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISH-02
DISPLAY DOES NOT DIM (NIGHT SCREEN) WITH TAIL SWITCH
ON
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK SYSTEM
Turn the light control switch to the TAIL or HEAD position.
Check if the illumination of the switches such as on the radio receiver assy comes on.
OK: Illumination of the switches comes on.
NG
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM (SEE
PAGE 05-1868 )
OK
2
CHECK IMAGE QUALITY SETTING
(a)
(b)
(c)
I39088
Enter the display adjustment screen by pressing the ”DISPLAY” switch.
Turn the light control switch to TAIL.
Check if ”DAY MODE” on the display adjustment is ON.
OK: ”DAY MODE” is ON.
OK
TURN FORCED ”DAY MODE” SETTING OFF
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1997
05-1808
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISI-02
PANEL SWITCH DOES NOT FUNCTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK THE PANEL SWITCH
Check for foreign matter around the switch that might prevent operation.
OK: No foreign matter is found.
NG
REMOVE ANY FOREIGN MATTER FOUND
OK
2
(a)
DISPLAY CHECK MODE(PANEL SWITCH CHECK MODE)
Enter the ”Display Check” mode (Panel Switch Check Mode) (see page 05-1762 ).
(b) Operate the abnormal switch and check if the switch
name and status are correctly displayed.
OK: The switch name and status are correctly displayed as operated.
OK
I38221
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLA Y
(SEE PAGE 67-8 )
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1998
05-1809
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISJ-02
TOUCH PANEL SWITCH DOES NOT FUNCTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK TOUCH PANEL
Check for dirt on the display surface.
OK: The display surface is clean.
NG
REMOVE ANY DIRT FOUND AND RECHECK
TOUCH PANEL
OK
2
(a)
DISPLAY CHECK MODE(TOUCH SWITCH CHECK)
Enter the ”Display Check” mode (Touch Switch Check) (see page 05-1761 ).
(b) Touch the display in the area where the abnormal switch
occurs.
OK: A ”+” mark appears at the touched position.
OK
I38219
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLA Y
(SEE PAGE 67-8 )
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1999
05-1810
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISK-02
SCREEN FLICKER OR COLOR DISTORTION
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DISPLAY SETTING
(a)
(b)
Enter the display adjustment screen by pressing the ”DISPLAY” switch.
Reset display settings (contrast, brightness) and check if
the screen appears normal.
I39089
(c)
Press the ”INFO” switch and then the ”Screen Setting”
switch.
(d)
Set the ”Background Color” to ”Green” (initial setting) and
check if it is normal.
OK: Returns to normal.
I39090
I39091
OK
END
NG
2
(a)
CHECK CABIN
Check if the cabin temperature is -20C (-4.0F) or less.
OK: Cabin is warmer than -20C (-4.0F).
NG
HEAT THE CABIN
TEMPERATURE
AND
RECHECK
THE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2000
05-181 1
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DISPLAY CHECK MODE(COLOR BAR CHECK MODE)
Enter the ”Display Check” mode (Color Bar Check Mode) (see page 05-1760 ).
(b) Check that color bars match the displayed names.
OK: Color bars match the displayed names.
NG
I38217
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLA Y
(SEE PAGE 67-8 )
OK
4
(a)
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE(NAVI COLOR BAR CHECK)
Enter the ”Navigation Check” mode (NAVI Color Bar Check) (see page 05-1766 ).
(b) Check that color bars match the displayed names.
OK: Color bars match the displayed names.
OK
I38230
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLA Y
(SEE PAGE 67-8 )
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2001
05-1846
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IT2-02
PARKING BRAKE SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is circuit from the parking brake switch to the multi-display.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
Passenger Side J/B
B
9
4M
12
4H
LG
4
IF3
Y
16
M3 PKB
1
P3
Parking Brake SW
I40220
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2036
05-1847
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK BRAKE WARNING LIGHT
Check that the brake warning light comes on when parking brake pedal is depressed, and goes off
when the parking brake pedal is released.
OK
Go to step 3
NG
2
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSY
(a)
(b)
ON
OFF
Disconnect the parking brake switch assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
Switch connector Switch body
ON (When shaft is not
pressed)
Below 1 Ω
Switch connector Switch body
OFF (When shaft is
pressed)
10 kΩ or higher
E71372
NG
REPLACE PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2037
05-1848
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PARKING BRAKE SWITCH MULTI-DISPLA Y)
(a)
Multi-Display:
(b)
M3
PKB
Disconnect the connector from multi-display and parking
brake switch assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
PKB - P3-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
PKB - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
I38678
Wire Harness Side
(Parking Brake Switch):
P3
NG
I40730
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLA Y (SEE PAGE 67-8 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2038
05-1760
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IRZ-02
DISPLAY CHECK MODE (COLOR BAR CHECK)
HINT:
1.
This mode checks the color display on the multi-display.
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
Enter diagnostic mode (see page 05-1784 ).
2.
Select ”Display Check” from the ”Diagnosis MENU”
screen.
3.
Select ”Color Bar Check” from the ”Display Check”
screen.
4.
Select a color bar from the ”Color Bar Check Mode”
screen.
I38215
I38216
HINT:
The entire screen turns to the color or stripe selected.
Touching the display will return to the ”Color Bar Check”
screen.
I38217
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1950
05-1762
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IS1-02
DISPLAY CHECK MODE (PANEL SWITCH CHECK)
HINT:
1.
This mode checks the panel switch operation response on the multi-display.
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
Enter diagnostic mode (see page 05-1784 ).
2.
Select ”Display Check” from the ”Diagnosis Menu”
screen.
3.
Select ”Panel Switch Check” from the ”Display
Check” screen.
4.
Operate each switch and check that the switch name
and condition is correctly displayed.
I38215
I38220
HINT:
*1
*2
Pressing the ”DISPLAY” switch for 3 seconds will exit the
diagnostic mode.
*3
I38221
Display
Push switch name/*1
Contents
Name of the pressed switch is displayed.
If more than one switch is pressed, ”MULTIPLE” is displayed.
Rotary switch name/*2
Name of the rotary switch is displayed.
Rotary switch direction/*3
Direction of the rotary switch is rotated.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1952
05-1761
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IS0-02
DISPLAY CHECK MODE (TOUCH SWITCH CHECK)
HINT:
1.
This mode checks the touch switch operation condition on the multi-display.
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
Enter diagnostic mode (see page 05-1784 ).
2.
Select ”Display Check” from the ”Diagnosis MENU”
screen.
3.
Select ”Touch Switch Check” from the ”Display
Check” screen.
4.
Touch the display anywhere in the open area to perform the check when the ”Touch Switch Check”
screen is displayed.
I38215
I38218
HINT:
A ”+” mark is displayed where the display is touched.
The ”+” mark remains on the display even after the finger
is removed.
I38219
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1951
05-1763
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IS2-02
DISPLAY CHECK MODE (VEHICLE SIGNAL CHECK)
HINT:
1.
This mode checks the vehicle signal status input to the multi-display.
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
Enter diagnostic mode (see page 05-1784 ).
2.
Select ”Display Check” from the ”Diagnosis MENU”
screen.
3.
Select ”Vehicle Signal Check” from the ”Display
Check” screen.
4.
When the ”Vehicle Signal Check Mode” screen is displayed, check all the vehicle signal conditions.
I38215
I38222
HINT:
Only conditions having inputs are displayed.
This screen is updated once per second when input signals to the vehicle are changed.
I38223
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1953
05-1768
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IS7-02
DIAGNOSIS DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION
HINT:
1.
(a)
This section contains a detailed description of displays within diagnostic mode.
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
System Check
System Check Mode Display
*1
*2 *1 *3
*2 *4
I38587
Device Names and Hardware Address/*1
HINT:
Registered device names are displayed below.
If a device name is unknown to the system, its physical address is shown instead.
Address No.
Name
Address No.
Name
110
EMV
120
AVX
128
1DIN TV
140
AVN
144
G-BOOK
178
NAVI
17C
MONET
190
AUDIO H/U
1AC
CAMERA-C
1B0
Rr-TV
1C0
Rr-CONT
1C2
TV-TUNER2
1C4
PANEL
1C6
G/W
1C8
FM-M-LCD
1D8
CONT-SW
1EC
Body
1F0
RADIO TUNER
1F1
XM
1F2
SIRIUS
230
TV-TUNER
240
CD-CH2
250
DVD-CH
280
CAMERA
360
CD-CH1
3A0
MD-CH
17D
TEL
440
DSP-AMP
530
ETC
5C8
MAYDAY
1A0
DVD-P
1C6
CLOCK
1F4
RSA
1F6
RSE
480
AMP
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1958
05-1769
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Check Result/*2
HINT:
Result codes for all devices are shown below.
Result
Meaning
Action
OK
The device did not respond with a DTC (excluding communication DTCs from the AVC-LAN).
-
EXCH
The device responds with a ”replace”-type DTC.
Look up the DTC in ”Unit Check Mode” and replace the device.
CHEK
The device responds with a ”check”-type DTC.
Look up the DTC in ”Unit Check Mode”.
NCON
The device was previously present, but does not respond in
diagnostic mode.
1. Check power supply wire harness of the device.
2. Check the AVC-LAN of the device.
The device responds with an ”old”-type DTC.
Look up the DTC in ”Unit Check Mode”.
The device responds in diagnostic mode, but gives no DTC
information.
1. Check power supply wire harness of the device.
2. Check the AVC-LAN of the device.
Old
NRES
Code Clear/*3
Present DTCs are cleared.
Memory Clear/*4
Present and past DTCs and registered connected device names are cleared.
(b) Diagnosis MENU Display
I38666
HINT:
Each item is grayed out or not displayed based on the device settings.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1959
05-1770
DIAGNOSTICS
(c)
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Unit Check Mode Screen
*1
*6
*5
*2 *3
*4
I38588
Screen Description
Display
Contents
Device name/*1
Target Device
Segment/*2
Target Device Logical address
DTC/*3
DTC (Diagnostic Trouble Code)
The time and date of past DTCs are displayed. (The year is displayed in 2 digit
format.)
Timestamp/*4
Present Code/*5
The DTC output at the service check is displayed.
Past Code/*6
(d)
Diagnostic memory results and recorded DTCs are displayed.
LAN Monitor (Original) Screen
*1
I38589
Check Result
HINT:
Check results of all the devices are displayed.
Result
Meaning
Action
No Err
(OK)
There are no communication DTCs.
CHEK
The device responds with a ”check”-type DTC.
Look up the DTC in ”Unit Check Mode”.
NCON
The device was previously present, but does not respond in
diagnostic mode.
1. Check power supply wire harness of the device.
2. Check the AVC-LAN of the device.
The device responded with an old-type DTC.
Look up the DTC in ”Unit Check Mode”.
Device responds in diagnostic mode, but gives no DTC
information.
1. Check power supply wire harness of the device.
2. Check the AVC-LAN of the device.
Old
NRES
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1960
05-1771
DIAGNOSTICS
(e)
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
LAN Monitor (Individual) Screen
*1
*2
*3
*4
*5
*6
I38590
Screen Description
Display
Device name/*1
Segment/*2
DTC/*3
Sub-Code (device address)/*4
Connection check No./*5
DTC occurrence/*6
2.
(a)
Contents
Target device
Target logical address
DTC (Diagnostic Trouble Code)
Physical address stored with DTC. (If there is no address, nothing is displayed.)
Connection check number stored with DTC.
Number of times the same DTC has been recorded.
DISPLAY CHECK
Vehicle Signal Check Mode Screen
I38591
Screen Description
Name
Battery
Contents
Battery voltage is displayed.
PKB
Parking brake ON/OFF state is displayed.
REV
Reverse signal ON/OFF state is displayed.
IG
ADIM/TCAN
SPEED
TAIL
IG switch ON/OFF state is displayed.
Brightness state DIM (with)/ BRIGHT (without) is displayed.
The vehicle speed, displayed in km/h.
TAIL signal (Head lamp dimmer switch) ON/OFF state is displayed.
HINT:
Only items sending a vehicle signal will be displayed.
This screen is updated once per second when input signals to the vehicle are changed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1961
05-1772
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
(a)
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NAVIGATION CHECK
Navigation Check MENU Screen
I38667
HINT:
Each item is grayed out or not displayed based on the device settings.
(b) GPS information Screen
*1
*1
*2
*2
*5
*3
*4
I38592
Satellite information/*1
Information from a maximum of 12 satellites is displayed on the screen. This information includes the target
GPS satellite number, elevation angle, direction and signal level.
Receiving condition/*2
(DENSO model)
Display
Contents
T
The system is receiving a GPS signal, but is not using it for location.
P
The system is using the GPS signal for location.
-
The system cannot receive a GPS signal.
(AISIN AW Model)
Display
Contents
01H
The system cannot receive a GPS signal.
02H
The system is tracing a satellite.
03H
The system is receiving a GPS signal, but is not using it for location.
04H
The system is using the GPS signal for location.
Measurement information/*3
Display
Contents
2D
2-dimensional location method is being used.
3D
3-dimensional location method is being used.
NG
Location data cannot be used.
Error
Reception error has occurred.
-
Any other state.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1962
05-1773
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Position information/*4
Display
Position
Contents
Latitude and longitude information on the current position is displayed.
Date information/*5
Display
Date
(c)
Contents
The date/time information obtained from GPS signal is displayed in Greenwich
mean time (GMT). The last 4 digits are displayed.
Vehicle Signal Check Screen
*1
*2
*3
I38593
Vehicle signal
Display
Contents
REV/*1
REV signal ON/OFF state is displayed.
SPD/*2
SPD signal condition is displayed.
Sensor signal
Display
Gyro sensor/*3
Contents
Gyro sensor output condition is displayed (when the vehicle runs straight or is stationary, the voltage is approximately 2.5 V).
HINT:
Signals are updated once per second only when vehicle sensor signals are changed.
(d) Parts Information Screen
*1
*2
*3
*4
I38594
Screen description
Display
Navigation Manufacturer/*1
Contents
Navigation ECU manufacturer is displayed.
Navigation Version No./*2
Navigation ECU version is displayed.
Disc Manufacturer/*3
Map disc manufacturer is displayed.
Disc Version No./*4
Map disc version is displayed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1963
05-1774
DIAGNOSTICS
(e)
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Memory Copy/Paste Screen
I38595
HINT:
This function cannot be used.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1964
05-1784
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISA-02
DIAGNOSTIC START-UP/FINISH
HINT:
1.
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
After the ignition switch is turned on, check that the map is displayed before starting the diagnostic
mode. Otherwise, some items cannot be checked.
There are 2 methods to start diagnostic mode. Start the mode by using one of them.
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Method 1
Start the engine.
While pressing and holding ”INFO” switch, operate light
control switch, OFF → TAIL → OFF → TAIL → OFF →
TAIL → OFF.
The diagnostic mode starts and the service check screen
(”System Check Mode”) will be displayed. Service inspection starts automatically and the result will be displayed.
I40190
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
I38204
4.
(a)
Method 2
Start the engine.
Switch to the ”Display Check” screen.
From the display adjustment screen, touch the corners of
the screen in the following order: upper left → lower left
→upper left → lower left → upper left → lower left.
The diagnostic mode starts and ”Service Check” screen
will be displayed. Service inspection starts automatically
and the result will be displayed.
Diagnosis MENU
Diagnostic screen will be displayed by pressing the menu
switch on the service check screen.
I38205
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1974
05-1785
DIAGNOSTICS
5.
(a)
(b)
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
There are 2 methods to exit. Use one of them.
Turn the ignition switch off.
Press the ”Display” switch for 3 seconds.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1975
05-1864
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IT9-02
AVC-LAN CIRCUIT (MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Each unit of the navigation system connected to AVC-LAN (communication bus) communicates by transferring the signals from each switch.
When +B short and GND short occur in this AVC-LAN, navigation system will not function normally as communication is discontinued.
In AVC-LAN, multi-display becomes the communication master, and the radio receiver assy has enough
resistance necessary for transmitting the communication.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy
Radio Receiver Assy
31
TX+ R29
LG
9
IP1
Y
9
R23 TX1+
30
TX- R29
GR
19
IP1
L
10
R23 TX1-
I39199
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2054
05-1865
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(a)
R23
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
TX1+ - TX1-
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TX1TX1+
I40222
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER
SUB-ASSY - RADIO RECEIVER ASSY)
(a)
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
(b)
R29
TX+
TXI34639
Disconnect the connectors from the multi-display controller sub-assy R29 and radio receiver assy R23.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
TX+ - TX1+
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX- - TX1-
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
TX- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Radio Receive Assy:
R23
TX1+
TX1-
NG
I40203
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2055
05-1834
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISY-02
POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT (GATEWAY ECU)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to the gateway ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
G
RAD No.2
2
1C
L
Gateway ECU
Center J/B
Instrument Panel J/B
IG1
7
10
1C
1K
GR
10
3A
1
3I
B
2
G5 IG
W
8
3A
1
3D
SB
9
G5 ACC
9
3F
8
3F
LG
8
G5 BATT
6
1J
Passenger Side J/B
LG
11
IL2
11
4D
V
I15
IGNITION SW
ACC
3
4
W
1
V
12
IK3
V
Instrument Panel J/B
W
IG1 AM1
F7
FL Block
ALT
6
4H
2
AM1
6
1C
2
1
1A
1
B
2
Engine Room J/B
W
3
D.C.C
1
2I
DOME
3
2A
Center J/B
W-B
13
3F
5
3G
W-B
6
3G
W-B
7
G5 CG
14
G5 GND
FL MAIN
Battery
IB
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
I39187
Author:
Date:
2024
05-1835
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT GATEWAY ECU(BATT, ACC, IG, GND ,CG)
(a)
(b)
G5
CG
IG
BATT
GND
(c)
ACC
I40180
Disconnect the gateway ECU connector G5.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
CG - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
BATT - GND or CG
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC - GND or CG
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
IG - GND or CG
Ignition SW ON
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2025
05-1858
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IT6-02
AVC-LAN CIRCUIT (MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY MULTI-DISPLA Y)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Each unit of the navigation system connected to AVC-LAN (communication bus) communicates by transferring the signals from each switch.
When +B short and GND short occur in this AVC-LAN, navigation system will not function normally as communication is discontinued.
In AVC-LAN, multi-display becomes the communication master, and the radio receiver assy has enough
resistance necessary for transmitting the communication.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display controller sub-assy
Multi-display
17
TX3+ R29
BR *1
1
IP1
LG *1
13
M4 TX+
18
TX3- R29
Y *1
11
IP1
O *1
14
M4 TX-
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
I39199
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2048
05-1859
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER
SUB-ASSY - MULTI-DISPLA Y)
(a)
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
R29
(b)
TX3+
TX3I34639
Disconnect the connector from the multi-display controller sub-assy R29 and multi-display M4.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
TX3+ - TX+
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX3- - TX-
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX3+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
TX3- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Multi-Display:
M4
TX+
NG
TXI38998
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2049
05-1854
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IT5-02
DIMMER SIGNAL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the light control switch is in the TAIL or HEAD position, the TAILLIGHT relay activates and supplies
power to illuminate the multi-display panel.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2044
05-1855
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
C11
Combination Meter
Center J/B
B
7
V
12
22 W-B
Multi-display Assy
5
3F
3
3F
3
3D
9
3F
10
13
3F
4
3I
3E
12
3A
2
M3 ILL-
B
LG
W-B
1
M3 ILL+
G
Passenger Side J/B
12
IK3
6
4H
V
11
4D
V
11
IL2
Engine Room J/B
3
2A
R
DOME
D.C.C
1
2I
W
Instrument Panel J/B
7
1K
4
1J
O
Taillight System
PANEL TAILLIGHT Relay 1
1A
3
5
2
B
1
F7
FL Block
W
1
ALT
2
3
FL MAIN
Battery
IB
I40219
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2045
05-1856
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK SYSTEM
Turn the light control switch to the TAIL or HEAD position.
Check if the illumination of the switches such as on the radio receiver assy comes on.
OK: Illumination of the switches comes on.
NG
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
(SEE PAGE 05-1868 )
OK
2
INSPECT MULTI-DISPLA Y(ILL+)
(a)
(b)
M3
ILL+
I38678
Disconnect the connector from the multi-display.
Measure the voltage according to the values in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
ILL+ - Body ground
Light control switch
TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2046
05-1857
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(COMBINATION METER ASSY MULTI-DISPLA Y)
(a)
Combination Meter Assy:
(b)
C11
ILL
Disconnect the connectors from the combination meter
assy and Multi-display.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
ILL - ILL-
Always
Below 1 Ω
ILL - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
I40182
Multi-Display:
M3
ILL-
NG
I38678
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN ON PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2047
05-1849
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IT3-02
SPEAKER CIRCUIT (NAVIGATION VOICE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit is used when the voice guidance in the navigation system is on.
WIRING DIAGRAM
T11
Front No.2 Speaker Assy LH
R
3
F10
Front No.1
Speaker
Assy LH
Navigation ECU
P
7
IB1
P
10
IF3
G
2
N3 AUO+
V
6
IB1
G
20
IF3
B
11
N3 AUO-
1
1
2
W
4
2
I39193
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2039
05-1850
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSY NAVIGATION ECU)
(a)
Navigation ECU:
(b)
N3
AUO+
AUO-
Disconnect the connectors from the navigation ECU and
speaker.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AUO+ - T11-1
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUO- - T11-2
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUO+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
AUO- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Wire Harness Side:
Front No.2 Speaker Assy
T11
NG
I40178
I38999
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
I40553
OK
2
(a)
INSPECT FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSY
Check that malfunction disappears when another speaker in a good condition is installed.
OK: Malfunction disappears
HINT:
Connect all the connectors to the speakers.
When there is a possibility that either right or left front speaker is defective, inspect by interchanging
the right one and the left one.
OK
REPLACE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-1 1)
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2040
05-1851
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSY - FRONT
NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side:
Front No.2 Speaker Assy
T11
(b)
Wier Harness Side:
Front No.1 Speaker Assy
Disconnect the connectors from the front No.2 speaker
assy and front No.1 speaker assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
3 (No.2 speaker) 1 (No.1 speaker)
Always
Below 1 Ω
4 (No.2 speaker) 2 (No.1 speaker)
Always
Below 1 Ω
3 (No.2 speaker) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
4 (No.2 speaker) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
F10
I38999
I38233
NG
I40554
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
4
INSPECT FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSY
(a)
Resistance check.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the speaker.
NOTICE:
The speaker should not be removed for checking.
Standard: Approximately 4 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-10 )
OK
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU (SEE PAGE 67-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2041
05-1830
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05CEG-08
POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT (NAVIGATION ECU)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to the navigation ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B
RAD No.2
2
1C
Navigation ECU
Center J/B
3
1K
V
13
3A
9
3F
10
3I
7
3I
GR
W
18
N3 ACC
9
N3 +B
Passenger Side J/B
LG
11
IL2
I15
IGNITION SW
L
W
3
ACC AM1
F7
FL Block
6
4H
11
4D
V
2
1
12
IK3
Instrument Panel J/B
AM1
1
6
1C
1A
2
1
ALT
W
V
B
2
W
3
Engine Room J/B
D.C.C DOME
1
2I
3
2A
V
2
3I
W-B
Center J/B
W-B
13
3F
17
N3
GND1
FL MAIN
Battery
IB
I39189
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2020
05-1831
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT NAVIGATION ECU(+B, ACC, GND1)
(a)
(b)
N3
+B
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND1 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
(c)
ACC
GND1
I40178
Disconnect the navigation ECU connector N3.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
+B - GND1
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC - GND1
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE OR
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART (SEE PAGE 05-1778 OR 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2021
05-1838
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IT0-02
SPEED SIGNAL CIRCUIT (NAVIGATION ECU - COMBINATION
METER ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The navigation ECU receives the vehicle speed signal and information about the GPS antenna, and then
adjusts the vehicle position.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter Assy
Navigation ECU
Center J/B
13
C12
W
9
3J
12
3K
O
5
N3 SPD
I39191
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2028
05-1839
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(COMBINATION METER ASSY NAVIGATION ECU)
(a)
Navigation ECU:
(b)
N3
SPD
Disconnect the connector from the navigation ECU N3
and combination meter assy C12.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
SPD - C12-13
Always
Specified condition
Below 1 Ω
SPD - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
I40178
Combination Meter Assy:
C12
13
NG
I40181
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2029
05-1840
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSY
(a)
(b)
C12
13
I40187
Connect the combination meter assy connector C12.
Measure voltage.
(1) Adjust the shift lever to the neutral position.
(2) Jack up either one of the front wheels.
(3) Turn ignition switch to the ON position.
(4) Measure the voltage between terminal C12-13 and
body ground of combination meter assy when the
front wheels are turned slowly.
OK: Voltage is pulsed as shown below.
IG Voltage
(9 to 14 V)
Below 2 V
0
NG
Turn the wheel
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
(SEE PAGE 05-1868 )
OK
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU (SEE PAGE 67-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2030
05-1866
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ITA-02
AVC-LAN CIRCUIT (RADIO RECEIVER ASSY - MULTI-DISPLA Y)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Each unit of the navigation system connected to AVC-LAN (communication bus) communicates by transferring the signals from each switch.
When +B short and GND short occur in this AVC-LAN, navigation system will not function normally as communication is discontinued.
In AVC-LAN, multi-display becomes the communication master, and the radio receiver assy has enough
resistance necessary for transmitting the communication.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio Receiver Assy
Multi-Display
9
TX+ R22
LG *1
13
M4 TX+
10
TX- R22
O *1
14
M4 TX-
*1: w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
I34965
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2056
05-1867
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(a)
R22
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
TX+ - TX-
Always
60 to 80 Ω
TXTX+
I40221
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(RADIO RECEIVER ASSY MULTI-DISPLA Y)
(a)
Radio Receiver Assy:
R22
(b)
Disconnect the connector from the radio receiver assy
and multi-display.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
TX+ - TX+
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX- - TX-
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
TX- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
TX+
TX-
I40185
Multi-Display:
M4
TX+
TX-
NG
I38998
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2057
05-1828
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05CEF-10
POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT (MULTI-DISPLA Y)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to the multi-display.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B
Multi-Display
Center J/B
7
1C
ECU-IG
9
1K
R
1
3A
7
3G
O
10
M3 IG
2
1C
RAD No.2
3
1K
V
13
3A
3
3E
BR
11
M3 ACC
V
12
M3 +B1
G
L
J17
J/C
16
IK2
V
6
IL1
V
A
A
Engine Room R/B
CRT
V
2
I15
IGNITION SW
ACC
3
4
AM1
1
Instrument Panel J/B
6
1C
W
IG1
2
2
2
AM1
2
1
1A
1
F7
FL Block
ALT
W
1
B
2
W
3
FL MAIN
Battery
Center J/B
W-B
13
3F
6
3I
W-B
3
M3 GND1
IB
I39188
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2018
05-1829
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT MULTI-DISPLA Y(+B1, ACC, IG, GND1)
(a)
(b)
IG
ACC
M3
+B1
GND1
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND1 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
(c)
I38678
Disconnect the multi-display connector M3.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
+B1 - GND1
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC - GND1
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
IG - GND1
Ignition SW ON
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE OR
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART (SEE PAGE 05-1778 OR 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2019
05-1841
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05CEI-08
SPEED SIGNAL CIRCUIT (MULTI-DISPLA Y - COMBINATION
METER ASSY
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multi-display performs the switch operation control during running by receiving the vehicle speed signal
from the combination meter assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-Display
Combination Meter Assy
Center J/B
13
C12
W
9
3J
6
3F
W
25
M3 SPD
I39195
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2031
05-1842
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(COMBINATION METER ASSY MULTI-DISPLA Y)
(a)
Multi-Display:
(b)
M3
SPD
Disconnect the connector from the multi-display M3 and
combination meter assy C12.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
SPD - C12-13
Always
Specified condition
Below 1 Ω
SPD - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
I38678
Combination Meter Assy:
C12
13
NG
I40181
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2032
05-1843
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSY
(a)
(b)
C12
13
I40187
Connect the combination meter assy connector C12.
Measure voltage.
(1) Adjust the shift lever to the neutral position.
(2) Jack up either one of the front wheels.
(3) Turn ignition switch to the ON position.
(4) Measure the voltage between terminal C12-13 and
body ground of combination meter assy when the
front wheels are turned slowly.
OK: Voltage is pulsed as shown below.
IG Voltage
9 to 14 V
Below 2 V
0
NG
Turn the wheel
GO TO COMBINATION METER SYSTEM
(SEE PAGE 05-1868 )
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLA Y(SEE PAGE 67-8 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2033
05-1852
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IT4-02
DISPLAY SIGNAL CIRCUIT (NAVIGATION ECU - MULTI-DISPLA Y)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the display signal circuit from the navigation ECU to the multi-display.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Navigation ECU
Multi-display Assy
24
R M4
W
2
N4
R
25
G M4
R
7
N4
G
26
M4
G
3
N4
B
23
VR M4
B
1
N4
VR
27
SYNC M4
Y
B
28
VG M4
8
N4
6
N4
Shielded
SYNC
VG
I39192
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2042
05-1853
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(NAVIGATION ECU - MULTI-DISPLA Y)
(a)
Navigation ECU:
(b)
N4
R
B
VR
VG
SYNC
G
I40183
Multi-Display:
M4
VG
SYNC
B
VR
G
R
I38998
Disconnect the connector from the navigation ECU N4
and multi-display M4.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
R (N4) - R (M4)
Always
Below 1 Ω
G (N4) - G (M4)
Always
Below 1 Ω
B (N4) - B (M4)
Always
Below 1 Ω
SYNC (N4) - SYNC (M4)
Always
Below 1 Ω
VR (N4) - VR (M4)
Always
Below 1 Ω
VG (N4) - VG (M4)
Always
Below 1 Ω
R (N4 or M4) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
G (N4 or M4) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B (N4 or M4) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
SYNC (N4 or M4) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
VR (N4 or M4) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
VG (N4 or M4) Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN ON PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2043
05-1860
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IT7-02
AVC-LAN CIRCUIT (NAVIGATION ECU - MULTI-DISPLA Y)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Each unit of the navigation system connected to AVC-LAN (communication bus) communicates by transferring the signals from each switch.
When +B short and GND short occur in this AVC-LAN, navigation system will not function normally as communication is discontinued.
In AVC-LAN, multi-display becomes the communication master, and the radio receiver assy has enough
resistance necessary for transmitting the communication.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
Navigation ECU
4
TX1+ M3
SB
5
N4
TX+
5
M3
BR
10
N4
TX-
TX1-
I39190
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2050
05-1861
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(NAVIGATION ECU - MULTI-DISPLA Y)
(a)
Navigation ECU:
(b)
N4
TX+
TX-
I40183
Multi-Display:
Disconnect the connector from the navigation ECU N4
and multi-display M3.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
TX1+ - TX+
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX1- - TX-
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX1+ Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
TX1- Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
M3
TX1-
TX1+
I38678
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2051
05-1862
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IT8-02
AVC-LAN CIRCUIT (MULTI-DISPLA Y - GATEWAY ECU)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Each unit of the navigation system connected to AVC-LAN (communication bus) communicates by transferring the signals from each switch.
When +B short and GND short occur in this AVC-LAN, navigation system will not function normally as communication is discontinued.
In AVC-LAN, multi-display becomes the communication master, and the radio receiver assy has enough
resistance necessary for transmitting the communication.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-Display
Gateway ECU
11
TX3+ M4
BR
5
G5 GTX+
12
M4
L
12
G5 GTX-
TX3-
I34966
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2052
05-1863
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTI-DISPLA Y - GATEWAY ECU)
(a)
Multi-Display:
(b)
M4
TX3+
TX3-
I38998
Disconnect the connector from the multi-display M4 and
gateway ECU G5.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
TX3+ - GTX+
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX3- - GTX-
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX3+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
TX3- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Gateway ECU:
G5
GTX+
GTXI40180
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2053
05-1764
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IS3-02
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE (GPS INFORMATION)
HINT:
1.
This mode displays GPS satellite information.
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
Enter diagnostic mode (see page 05-1784 ).
2.
Select ”Navigation Check” from the ”Diagnosis
MENU” screen.
3.
Select ”GPS Information” from the ”Navigation
Check” screen.
4.
When GPS information is displayed, check the GPS
conditions.
I38224
I38225
HINT:
This screen is updated once per second when input signals to
the vehicle are changed.
I38226
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1954
05-1766
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IS5-02
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE (NAVI COLOR BAR CHECK)
HINT:
1.
This mode checks the color display on the navigation ECU.
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
Enter diagnostic mode (see page 05-1784 ).
2.
Select ”Navigation Check” from the ”Diagnosis
MENU” screen.
3.
Select ”Color Bar Check” from the ”Navigation
Check” screen.
4.
Check each color of the color bar when the ”NAVI Color Bar Check” screen is displayed.
I38224
I38229
HINT:
Colors will not be displayed full-screen as in ”Display Check
Mode”.
I38230
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1956
05-1767
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IS6-02
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE (PARTS INFORMATION)
HINT:
1.
This mode displays product information on the navigation systems and discs.
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
Enter diagnostic mode (see page 05-1784 ).
2.
Select ”Navigation Check” from the ”Diagnosis
MENU” screen.
3.
Select ”Parts Information” from the ”Navigation
Check” screen.
4.
Check the navigation and disc information when the
”Parts Information” screen is displayed.
I38224
I38231
*1
*2
*3
*4
I38232
Display
Navigation Manufacturer/*1
Contents
Navigation ECU manufacturer name is displayed.
Navigation Version/*2
Navigation ECU version is displayed.
Disc Manufacturer/*3
Map disc manufacturer is displayed.
Disc Version/*4
Map disc version is displayed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1957
05-1765
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IS4-02
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE (VEHICLE SENSORS)
HINT:
1.
This mode checks the vehicle signal status to the navigation ECU.
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
Enter diagnostic mode (see page 05-1784 ).
2.
Select ”Navigation Check” from the ”Diagnosis
MENU” screen.
3.
Select ”Vehicle Sensors” from the ”Navigation
Check” screen.
4.
Check all the signals and sensors when vehicle signal information is displayed.
I38224
I38227
HINT:
This screen is updated once per second when input signals to
the vehicle are changed.
I38228
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1955
05-1778
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IS9-02
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Before performing verification listed in the table below, check the fuse and relay.
Methods used to verify the cause of the problem are listed in order of probability in the verification column.
If there are two or more parts to be replaced in the verification column, check the symptom after replacing each part. If the symptom still occurs, replace the following part in the colummn.
Display function
Symptom
Verification
See page
05-1805
Black screen (No image appears on navigation/audio screen).
1. ”BLACK SCREEN (NO IMAGE APPEARS ON NAVIGATION AND AUDIO SCREEN)”
2. Power source circuit (multi-display)
3. Replace multi-display
1. ”ILLUMINATION FOR PANEL SWITCH DOES NOT
COME ON WITH TAIL SWITCH ON”
2. Dimmer signal circuit
3. Replace multi-display
05-1806
Illumination for panel switch does not come on with TAIL switch
on.
05-1807
Display does not dim (Night Screen) with TAIL switch on.
1. ”DISPLAY DOES NOT DIM (NIGHT SCREEN) WITH
TAIL SWITCH ON”
2. Replace multi-display
3. Replace gateway ECU
4. Replace combination meter assy
Power does not turn off (The screen remains on).
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. Replace multi-display
05-1828
67-8
Panel switch does not function.
1. ”PANEL SWITCH DOES NOT FUNCTION”
2. Power source circuit (multi-display)
3. Replace multi-display
05-1808
05-1828
67-8
Touch panel switch does not function.
1. ”TOUCH PANEL SWITCH DOES NOT FUNCTION”
2. Power source circuit (multi-display)
3. Replace multi-display
05-1809
05-1828
67-8
Screen is distorted.
1. Display signal circuit (navigation ECU - multi-display)
2. Replace navigation ECU
3. Replace multi-display
05-1852
67-9
67-8
Screen flicker or color distortion.
1.
2.
3.
4.
05-1810
05-1852
67-9
67-8
Switches can be operated while vehicle is running
1. Speed signal circuit (multi-display - combination meter
assy)
05-1841
DVD image cannot be displayed on front screen. (Parking brake
is on.) *1
1. Parking brake switch circuit
05-1846
”SCREEN FLICKER OR COLOR DISTORTION”
Display signal circuit (navigation ECU - multi-display)
Replace navigation ECU
Replace multi-display
05-1828
67-8
05-1854
67-8
67-8
67-21
71-18
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1968
05-1779
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Navigation function
Symptom
Verification
See page
Map disc cannot be inserted.
1. ”MAP DISC CANNOT BE INSERTED”
2. Power source circuit (navigation ECU)
3. Replace navigation ECU
05-1812
05-1830
67-9
Vehicle position mark deviates greatly.
1. ”VEHICLE POSITION MARK DEVIATES GREATLY”
2. Replace GPS antenna assy
3. Replace navigation ECU
05-1813
67-19
67-9
1. ”CURSOR OR MAP ROTATES WHEN VEHICLE IS
STOPPED”
2. Replace navigation ECU
05-1815
Cursor or map rotates when vehicle is stopped.
Vehicle position mark is not updated.
1. ”VEHICLE POSITION MARK IS NOT UPDATED”
2. Replace map disc
3. Replace navigation ECU
05-1816
67-9
05-1817
Current position display does not appear.
1. ”CURRENT POSITION DISPLAY DOES NOT APPEAR”
2. Replace map disc
3. Replace navigation ECU
GPS mark is not displayed.
1. ”GPS MARK IS NOT DISPLAYED”
2. Replace GPS antenna assy
3. Replace navigation ECU
05-1818
67-19
67-9
Voice guidance does not function.
1. ”VOICE GUIDANCE DOES NOT FUNCTION”
2. Speaker circuit (navigation voice)
05-1820
05-1849
Map display is incomplete.
1. ”MAP DISPLAY INCOMPLETE”
2. Replace map disc
3. Replace navigation ECU
05-1823
67-9
Route cannot be calculated.
1. ”ROUTE CANNOT BE CALCULATED”
2. Replace map disc
3. Replace navigation ECU
05-1824
67-9
67-9
67-9
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1969
05-1844
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IT1-02
REVERSE SIGNAL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The navigation ECU receives the reverse signal from the park/neutral position switch and information about
the GPS antenna, and then adjusts the vehicle position.
WIRING DIAGRAM
P1 Park/Neutral Position Switch
Navigation ECU
Center J/B
11
IF3
G
1
3C
13
3K
Y
14
N3 RL
Passenger Side J/B
GR
RL
13
4K
6
4A
L
20
IM1
R-B
1
I39194
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2034
05-1845
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
INSPECT REVERSE POSITION INDICATOR(COMBINATION METER ASSY)
When moving the shift lever to the R position, check if ”R” lights up in the combination meter.
OK: ”R” lights up.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2
INSPECT NAVIGATION ECU(RL)
(a)
(b)
N3
Disconnect the navigation ECU connector N3.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
RL - Body ground
Shift lever R position →
Except R position
10 to 14 V → Below 1 V
NG
RL
I40178
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU (SEE PAGE 67-9 )
3
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY
(a)
(b)
Park/Neutral Position Switch Assy:
P1
Disconnect the park/neutral position switch connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
G26080
Condition
Specified condition
P1-1 - P1-2
Shift lever is moved to R
position.
P1-1 - P1-2
Shift lever is moved to except R position.
NG
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2035
05-1836
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISZ-02
POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT(MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER
SUB-ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to the multi-display controller sub-assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
J17
J/C
Engine Room R/B
W *1
CRT
1
16
IK2
V *1
2
2
V *1
Passenger Side J/B
8
4D
A
G
A
A
B
1
1H
RAD No.2
1
1A
AM1
1
F7
FL Block
2
1C
6
1C
I15
Ignition SW
L
3 ACC
2
AM1
W
2
7
W-B
2
ALT
R31 SELD
C
W
J18
J/C
1
3
16
R29 +B1
32
R29 ACC
G *1
Instrument Panel J/B
Y
Y *1
J18
J/C
14
IO1
W
21
IO2
V *1
A
2
2
4E
Multi-display
Controller Sub-assy
C
W-B
29
R29 GND
C
W-B
FL MAIN
BF
Battery
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
I37210
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2026
05-1837
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY(+B1, ACC, GND, SELD)
R29
(a)
R31
(b)
+B1
ACC GND
SELD
I37211
(c)
Disconnect the connectors from the multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SELD - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
+B1 - GND
Always
10 - 14 V
ACC - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 - 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2027
05-1803
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISE-02
SCREEN NOISE AUTOMATIC ADJUSTMENT
HINT:
1.
This adjustment is performed to reduce noise when screen noise occurs upon replacing the multi-display, the navigation ECU or the television camera ECU.
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
Perform both procedures below when the multi-display is replaced.
When either the multi-display or the navigation ECU is replaced:
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and wait for
at least 6 seconds to activate the diagnostic mode (see
page 05-1784 ).
Select ”Navigation Check” from the ”Diagnosis MENU”
screen.
I39965
(c)
Completion mark (orange)
(d)
The screen enters ”Navigation Check” with a beeping
sound. Adjustment is completed when the completion
mark is displayed.
Cancel the diagnostic mode (see page 05-1784 ).
I38225
2.
When either the multi-display or the television camera ECU is replaced:
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and wait for
at least 6 seconds to activate the diagnostic mode (see
page 05-1784 ).
Select ”Camera Check” from the ”Diagnosis MENU”
screen.
I39965
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1993
05-1804
DIAGNOSTICS
(c)
(d)
HINT:
I39966
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Adjustment is completed when the steering angle setting
screen is displayed.
Cancel the diagnostic mode (see page 05-1784 ).
If the automatic adjustment is not performed (only step 1)
only upon replacing the multi-display, a beeping sound
can be heard for 3 seconds (while the initial screen is displayed) after turning the ignition switch to the ACC position.
Perform the automatic adjustment again if a beeping
sound can be heard within 3 seconds.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1994
05-1751
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IRW-01
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
(a)
Navigation system outline
Vehicle position tracking methods
It is essential that the navigation system correctly tracks the current vehicle position and displays it on
the map. There are 2 methods to track the current vehicle position: autonomous (dead reckoning) and
GPS* (satellite) navigation. Both navigation methods are used in conjunction with each other.
*GPS (Global Positioning System)
GPS satellite
Navigation ECU
Location by
autonomous navigation
Gyro Sensor
Location by
GPS navigation
GPS Antenna
ECU
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Navigation ECU
GPS Antenna
Receive satellite
radio wave
Detect the
measurement position
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Detect vehicle
running distance
GPS correction
Create the current
vehicle position
tracking data
Detect direction
change
Gyro Sensor
Map matching
correction
Map disc
Multi-display
Map and current vehicle
position data processing
Navigation screen
Map scrolling
Map scale switching
I39857
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1941
05-1752
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Operation
Description
Vehicle Position Calculation
The navigation ECU calculates the current vehicle position (direction and current
position) using the direction deviation signal from the gyro sensor and the running
distance signal from the vehicle speed sensor and creates the driving route.
Map Display processing
The navigation ECU displays the vehicle track on the map by processing the vehicle position data, vehicle running track, and map data from the map disc.
Map Matching
The map data from the map disc is compared to the vehicle position and running
track data. Then, the vehicle position is matched with the nearest road.
GPS Correction
The vehicle position is matched to the position measured by GPS. Then, the measurement position data from the GPS unit is compared with the vehicle position and
running track data. If the position is widely different, the GPS measurement position
is used.
Distance Correction
The running distance signal from the vehicle speed sensor includes the error
caused by tire wear and slippage between the tires and road surface. Distance
correction is performed to account for this. The navigation ECU automatically offsets the running distance signal to make up for the difference between it and the
distance data of the map. The offset is automatically updated.
HINT:
The combination of autonomous and GPS navigation makes it possible to display the vehicle position even
when the vehicle is in places where the GPS radio wave cannot receive a signal. When only autonomous
navigation is used, however, the mapping accuracy may slightly decline.
GPS satellite
Navigation performed even where the
GPS radio wave does not reach.
In a tunnel
In an indoor parking lot
Between tall buildings
Under an overpass
On a forest or tree-lined path
Autonomous navigation
Autonomous navigation and
GPS navigation
I38172
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1942
05-1753
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
(c)
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Autonomous navigation
This method determines the relative vehicle position based on the running track determined by the
gyro and vehicle speed sensors located in the navigation ECU.
(1) Gyro sensor
Calculates the direction by detecting angular velocity. It is located in the radio and navigation
assy.
(2) Vehicle speed sensor
Used to calculate the vehicle running distance.
GPS navigation (Satellite navigation)
This method detects the absolute vehicle position using radio wave from a GPS satellite.
* GPS satellites were launched by the U.S. Department of Defence for military purposes.
Current longitude/latitude/altitude is determined using the radio wave arrival time from four satellites.
GPS
I38174
Number of satellites
Measurement
2 or less
Measurement impossible
Vehicle position cannot be obtained because the number of satellites is not enough.
Description
3
2-dimensional measurement is possible
Vehicle position is obtained based on the current longitude and latitude. (This is less precise
than 3-dimensional measurement)
4
3-dimensional measurement is possible
Vehicle position is obtained based on the current longitude, latitude and altitude.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1943
05-1754
DIAGNOSTICS
(d)
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Map matching
The current driving route is calculated by autonomous navigation (according to the gyro sensor and
vehicle speed sensor) and GPS navigation. This information is then compared with possible road
shapes from the map data in the map disc and the vehicle position is set onto the most appropriate
road.
Start
Actual driving route
Driving route on the display
(Route by estimation)
Roads
A
The system compares the shape of the roads L1,
L2 and L3 to the estimated running track after the
vehicle makes a right turn. At point A, the vehicle
position differs enough from the shape of L1 that
the display switches to the road L2.
Map
Matching
I38177
2.
DVD (Digital Versatile Disc) player outline (for navigation map)
(a) The navigation ECU uses a laser pickup to read the digital signals recorded on a DVD.
HINT:
Do not disassemble any part of the navigation ECU.
Do not apply oil to the navigation ECU.
Do not insert anything but a DVD into the navigation ECU.
CAUTION:
Because the navigation ECU uses an invisible laser beam, do not look directly at the laser pickup.
Be sure to only operate the navigation as instructed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1944
05-1755
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
(a)
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Multi-display outline
Touch switch
Touch switches are touch-sensitive (interactive) switches operated by touching the screen. When a
switch is pressed, the outer glass bends in to contact the inner glass at the pressed position. By doing
this, the voltage ratio is measured and the pressed position is detected.
Outer
Inner
Vx1 (Vy1)
Vy1
Glass
Contact
Vx1
Vx2
Vy2
Vx2 (Vy2)
The touch switch detects the voltage ratio
and calculates the position on the screen.
Touch-sensitive switch position
I38179
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1945
05-1756
DIAGNOSTICS
4.
(a)
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN Description
What is AVC-LAN?
AVC-LAN, an abbreviation for ”Audio Visual Communication Local Area Network”, is a unified standard developed by the manufacturers in affiliation with Toyota Motor Corporation. This standard pertains to audio and visual signals as well as switch and communication signals.
Example:
Radio Receiver Assy
(Resister 60 to 80 Ω)
AVC-LAN
Multi-display
I39082
(b)
Purpose:
Recently, car audio systems have rapidly developed and the functions vastly changed. The conventional car audio system is being integrated with multi-media interfaces similar to those in navigation
systems. At the same time, customers are demanding higher quality from their audio systems. This
is merely an overview of the standardization background. The specific purposes are as follows.
(1) To solve sound problems, etc. caused by using components of different manufacturers through
signal standardization.
(2) To allow each manufacturer to concentrate on developing products they do best. From this, reasonably priced products can be produced.
HINT:
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
6.
(a)
(b)
If a +B or GND short is detected in the AVC-LAN circuit, communication is interrupted and the audio
system will stop functioning.
If an audio system is equipped with a navigation system, the multi-display unit acts as the master unit.
If the navigation system is not equipped, the audio head unit acts as the master unit instead. If the radio
and navigation assy is equipped, it is the master unit.
The radio receiver assy provides resistance to make communication possible.
The car audio system with an AVC-LAN circuit has a diagnostic function.
Each component has a specified number (3-digit) called a physical address. Each function has a number (2-digit) called a logical address.
Communication system outline
Components of the navigation system communicate with each other via the AVC-LAN.
Radio receiver assy has enough resistance (60 to 80 Ω) necessary for transmitting the communication.
This is essential for communication.
If a short circuit or open circuit occurs in the AVC-LAN circuit, communication is interrupted and the
navigation system will stop functioning.
Diagnostic function outline
The audio system has a diagnostic function (the result is indicated on the master unit).
A 3-digit hexadecimal component code (physical address) is allocated to each component on the
AVC-LAN. Using this code, the component in the diagnostic function can be displayed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1946
05-1775
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IS8-02
SYSTEM NORMAL CONDITION CHECK
(f)
If the symptom is applicable to any of the following, it is intended behavior, and not a malfunction.
Symptom
Answer
A longer route than expected is chosen.
Depending on the road conditions, the navigation ECU may determine that a longer
route is quicker.
Even when distance priority is high, the shortest route is not
shown.
Some paths may not be advised due to safety concerns.
When the vehicle is put into motion immediately after the
engine starts, the navigation system deviates from the actual position.
If the vehicle starts before the navigation system activates, the system may not
react.
When running on certain types of roads, especially new
roads, the vehicle position deviates from the actual position.
When the vehicle is driving on new roads not available on the map disc, the system
attempts to match it to another nearby road, causing the position mark to deviate.
(g)
The following symptoms are not a malfunction, but are
caused by errors inherent in the GPS, gyro sensor, speed
sensor, and navigation ECU.
(1) The current position mark may be displayed on a
nearby parallel road the vehicle actually runs on.
I38139
(2)
Immediately after a fork in the road, the current vehicle position mark may be displayed on the wrong
road.
(3)
When the vehicle turns right or left at an intersection, the current vehicle position mark may be displayed on a nearby parallel road.
I38140
I38141
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1965
05-1776
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(4)
When the vehicle is carried, such as on a ferry, and
the vehicle itself is not running, the current vehicle
position mark may be displayed in the position
where the vehicle was until a measurement can be
performed by GPS.
(5)
When the vehicle runs on a steep hill, the current vehicle position mark may deviate from the correct
position.
(6)
When the vehicle makes a continuous turn of 360,
720, 1,080, etc. degrees, the current vehicle position mark may deviate from the correct position.
(7)
When the vehicle moves erratically, such as
constant lane changes, the current vehicle position
mark may deviate from the correct position.
(8)
When the ignition switch is put into the ACC/OFF
position on a turn table before parking, the current
vehicle position mark may not point in the correct
direction. The same will occur when the vehicle
comes out of parking.
I38142
I38143
I38144
I38145
I38146
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1966
05-1777
DIAGNOSTICS
-
(9)
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
When the vehicle runs on the snowy road or a
mountain path with the chains installed or using a
spare tire, the current vehicle position mark may
deviate from the correct position.
I38147
(10) When a tire is changed, the current vehicle position
mark may deviate from the correct position.
HINT:
Diameter of the tire may change, causing a speed sensor
error.
Performing the ”tire change” in calibration mode will allow
the system to correct the current vehicle position faster.
I38148
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1967
05-1789
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISC-02
SYSTEM CHECK MODE (DTC CLEAR/RECHECK)
HINT:
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore,
some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
1.
Enter the diagnostic mode (see page 05-1784 ).
2.
(a)
Clear DTC
Press the ”Code CLR” switch for 3 seconds.
(b)
3.
(a)
Check result is cleared.
Recheck
Press the ”Recheck” switch.
I38211
I38212
(b)
Confirm that all diagnostic codes are ”OK” when the
check results are displayed.
If a code other than ”OK” is displayed, troubleshoot again.
I38213
(c)
Press the ”LAN Mon” switch to change to ”LAN Monitor”
mode.
I38213
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1979
05-1790
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(d) Confirm that all diagnostic codes are ”No Err”.
If a code other than ”No Err” is displayed, troubleshoot again.
I38214
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1980
05-1786
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISB-02
SYSTEM CHECK MODE (DTC CHECK)
HINT:
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on the device settings and options. Therefore,
some detailed areas may not be shown exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
1.
Enter the diagnostic mode (see page 05-1784 ).
2.
(a)
Read the system check result.
If all check results of other devices are ”EXCH,” ”CHEK”
or ”Old,” touch the display to check the contents on the
”Unit Check Mode” screen and record them on the customer problem analysis check sheet.
HINT:
Diagnostic Code
Logical Address
If all check results are ”OK,” go to communication DTC
check (go to step 3).
If a device name is not known, its physical address is displayed.
I38206
HINT:
If ”EXCH”, ”CHEK” and ”Old” as well as ”OK” exist, press the
service switch to return to the ”System Check Mode”. Then,
check the ”Unit Check Mode” screen and record them on the
customer problem analysis check sheet.
Diagnostic Code
Logical Address
I38207
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1976
05-1787
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
3.
(a)
Read the communication diagnostic check result.
Return to the ”System Check Mode”, and press ”LAN
Mon” switch to enter the LAN monitor screen.
(b)
If the result is ”CHEK” or ”Old,” touch the result switch to
check the contents on the individual communication diagnostic screen and record them on the customer problem
analysis check sheet.
I38208
HINT:
Diagnostic Code
Logical Address
If all check results are ”No Err,” the system judges that no
DTC exists.
The sub-code (relevant device) will be indicated by its
physical address.
Sub-Code
I38209
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1977
05-1788
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
HINT:
If check results of other devices are ”CHEK,” press the ”Service”
switch to return to the original ”LAN Monitor” screen. Then,
check the individual communication diagnostic screen for the
next device and record the result on the customer problem analysis check sheet.
I38210
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1978
05-1749
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IRV-01
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
: AVC-LAN
Front
Driver
Side
Speaker
GPS Antenna
Vehicle Speed
Signal
Reverse
Signal
Navigation
ECU
RGB Image Signal
Gateway
ECU
Multi-display
*1
Radio
Receiver
Assy
Vehicle Speed
Signal
Parking
Brake Signal
*2
Multi-display
Controller
Sub-assy
*2
*1: w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
*2: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
I40742
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1939
05-1759
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IRY-02
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
NAVIGATION SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
VIN
Production Date
Customer’s Name
Licence Plate No.
Date Vehicle
Brought in
/
/
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Frequency Problem Occurs
km
mile
Odometer Reading
Always
Intermittently (
/
Times a day)
DTC Check
1st time trouble code.
2nd time trouble code.
Problem Symptom
I39529
I38696
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1949
05-1791
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05ISD-02
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Terms
Description
Physical address
3-digit, hexadecimal code assigned to all components connected to the AVC-LAN.
Individual symbols are specified based on function. Units whose names are unknown or relevant units are displayed with physical addresses.
Logical address
2-digit, hexadecimal code assigned to all the functions in the AVC-LAN system.
HINT:
Titles for each unit are stated in the following order: parts name (physical address) [Name indicated by DTC]
1.
MULTI-DISPLA Y (physical address: 110) [EMV]
(a) Logical address: 01 (Communication control)
DTC
Name
Diagnosis
D5
*1
*5
Absence of registration unit
A device that the sub code shows is (was) disconnected from the system when turning the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position.
The communication condition with the device that
the code shows cannot be obtained when the engine starts.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
D8
*2
*5
No response for connection
check
The device indicated by the sub code is (was)
disconnected from the system after engine start.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
D9
*1
*5
Last mode error
The device (for audio visual system) that had
functioned before the engine stopped is (was)
disconnected from the system when the ignition
switch is (was) in the ACC or ON position.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
DA
*5
No response against ON/OFF
command
No response is identified when changing mode
(audio and visual mode change). Detected when
sound and image do not change by switch operation.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
This code detects a dual alarm.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
This code indicates a transmission failure to the
device indicated by the sub code.
NOTE: This DTC may have no direct relationship
with the malfunction.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
Refer to
step 6
DB
*1
*5
DC
*3
*5
Mode status error
Failure in transmission
Verification
See page
DE
*4
*5
Slave reset
Inspection for the device indicated
This code is stored when a slave device has been by the sub code.
disconnected after engine start.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
21
ROM error
This code is output when a malfunction exists in
ROM.
Replace multi-display
67-8
22
RAM error
This code is output when a malfunction exists in
RAM.
Replace multi-display
67-8
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1981
05-1792
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
HINT:
(b)
*1: This code may be recorded depending on the battery condition or engine start voltage even if no
failure is detected.
*2: If the power connector is disconnected after the engine starts, this code is recorded after 180 seconds.
*3: This code may be stored if the ignition key is turned to the START position again with the engine
running.
*4: This code may be stored if the ignition key is held in the START position for 1 minute or more before
returning to the ON position.
*5: If the device is reported as not existing during verification, check the power source circuit and AVCLAN circuit for the device.
Logical address: 21 (SW): 23 (SW with name): 24 (SW converting): 25 (command SW)
DTC
Name
10
Panel switch error
Diagnosis
Verification
The panel SW detection circuit has a failure.
Replace multi-display
See page
67-8
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1982
05-1793
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2.
NAVIGATION ECU (Physical address: 178) [NAVI]
(a) Logical address: 01 (Communication control)
HINT:
Methods used to verify the cause of the problem are listed in order of probability in the verification column.
DTC
D6
*1
D7
DC
*3
*5
DD
*3
DF
*4
E0
*1
E1
*1
Name
No master
Connection check error
Diagnosis
Verification
See page
05-1828
When either the following condition meets.
The device that stores (stored) the code has
(had) been disconnected when the ignition
switch is in ACC or ON position.
The master device has (had) been disconnected
when this code is stored.
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display navigation ECU)
3. Power source circuit (navigation
ECU)
4. Replace multi-display
5. Replace navigation ECU
05-1828
When either the following condition meets.
The device that stored this code has (had) been
disconnected after the engine starts (started).
The master device has (had) been disconnected
when this code is (was) stored.
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display navigation ECU)
3. Power source circuit (navigation
ECU)
4. Replace multi-display
5. Replace navigation ECU
05-1860
05-1830
67-8
67-9
05-1860
05-1830
67-8
67-9
This code indicates a transmission failure to the
device indicated by the sub code.
NOTE: This DTC may have no direct relationship
with the malfunction.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code)
05-1828
When the device that should be the master has
been disconnected after engine starts.
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display navigation ECU)
3. Replace multi-display
When the device with a display fails and the master is switched to the audio device.
Also when a communication error between sub
master (audio) and master occurs, this code is
stored.
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display navigation ECU)
3. Replace multi-display
05-1828
Registration complete indication
error
When ”Registration complete” command from the
master device cannot be received.
This code will be detected when signal receiving time is delayed
Voice processing device ON
error
When the AMP device records that the AMP output does not function even while the source device operates.
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display navigation ECU)
3. Replace multi-display
Failure in transmission
Master reset
Master error
Refer to
step 6
05-1860
67-8
05-1860
67-8
05-1828
05-1860
67-8
ON/OFF indication parameter
error
When the command for ON/OFF control from the
master device has a problem.
E3
*1
Registration demand
transmission
When the registration demand command from the
slave device is output, or when the registration
demand command is output by receiving connection confirmation command from the sub master
device.
-
-
E4
Multiple frame incomplete
When the multiple frame transmission ends incomplete.
-
-
Date:
1983
E2
Replace multi-display
67-8
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
05-1794
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
HINT:
*1: This code may be recorded depending on the battery condition or engine start voltage even if no
failure is detected.
*2: If the power connector is disconnected after the engine starts, this code is recorded after 180 seconds.
*3: This code may be stored if the ignition key is turned to the START position again with the engine
running.
*4: This code may be stored if the ignition key is held in the START position for 1 minute or more before
returning to the ON position.
*5: If the device is reported as not existing during verification, check the power source circuit and AVCLAN circuit for the device.
Logical address: 58 (Navigation): 80 (GPS)
(b)
HINT:
Methods used to verify the cause of the problem are listed in order of probability in the verification column.
DTC
Name
Diagnosis
10
Gyro error
Ground short, power supply short, or open circuit
in the gyro signal, gyro failure.
1. Inspect the gyro error
2. Replace GPS antenna
3. Replace navigation ECU
11
GPS receiver error
RTC, ROM, and RAM of the GPS receiver and
TCXO errors. GPS receiver is failed.
Replace navigation ECU
67-9
40
GPS antenna error
GPS antenna error
1. Replace GPS antenna
2. Replace navigation ECU
67-19
67-9
41
GPS antenna power source
error
Error of the power source to the GPS antenna
1. Replace GPS antenna
2. Replace navigation ECU
67-19
67-9
42
Map disc read error
Player error. A scratch or dirt on the disc.
Access to an invalid address due to software error.
1. Inspect map disc read error
2. Replace map disc
3. Replace navigation ECU
05-1826
67-9
43
SPD signal error
The difference between the GPS speed and SPD
pulse is detected.
1. Inspect speed signal error
2. Speed signal circuit
3. Replace navigation ECU
05-1827
05-1838
67-9
67-9
Map player error is detected.
1. Check if the disc can be inserted
and ejected. If a malfunction is
found, replace the navigation
ECU
2. If the same code is detected
again, replace the navigation
ECU
1. Park the vehicle in a cool place.
Turn the engine off. After checking that the temperature of the
radio and navigation assy becomes sufficiently low, turn the
engine on to verify the malfunction symptom.
2. If the same code is detected, replace the navigation ECU
-
44
45
Player error
High temperature
High map player temperature is detected.
Verification
See page
05-1825
67-19
67-9
67-9
67-9
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1984
05-1795
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
3.
RADIO RECEIVER ASSY (Physical address: 190) [AUDIO H/U]
(a) Logical address: 01 (Communication control)
HINT:
Methods used to verify the cause of the problem are listed in order of probability in the verification column.
DTC
D6
*1
D7
DC
*3
*5
Name
No master
Connection check error
Failure in transmission
Diagnosis
Verification
See page
05-1828
When either of the following conditions meets.
The device that stores (stored) the code has
(had) been disconnected when the ignition
switch is (was) in ACC or ON position.
The master device has (had) been disconnected
when this code is (was) stored.
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display radio receiver assy) *6
3. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
4. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
5. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display
controller sub-assy-radio receiver assy)
6. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display
controller sub-assy-multi-display)
7. Replace multi-display
8. Replace radio receiver assy
9. Replace multi-display controller
sub-assy
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display radio receiver assy) *6
3. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
4. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
5. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display
controller sub-assy-radio receiver assy)
6. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display
controller sub-assy-multi-display)
7. Replace multi-display
8. Replace radio receiver assy
9. Replace multi-display controller
sub-assy
05-1828
When either of the following conditions meets.
The device that stored this code has (had) been
disconnected after the engine starts (started).
The master device has (had) been disconnected
when this code is (was) stored.
This code indicates a transmission failure to the
device indicated by the sub code.
NOTE: This DTC may have no direct relationship
with the malfunction.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
05-1866
05-1832
05-1836
05-1864
05-1858
67-8
67-6
67-23
05-1866
05-1832
05-1836
05-1864
05-1858
67-8
67-6
67-23
Refer to
step 6
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1985
05-1796
DIAGNOSTICS
DD
*3
DF
*4
E0
*1
E1
*1
E2
Master reset
Master error
Registration complete indication
error
Voice processing device ON
error
ON/OFF indication parameter
error
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
When the device that should be the master has
been disconnected after engine starts.
When the device with a display fails and the master is switched to the audio device.
Also when a communication error between sub
master (audio) and master occurs, this code is
stored.
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display radio receiver assy) *6
3. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
4. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
5. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display
controller sub-assy-radio receiver assy)
6. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display
controller sub-assy-multi-display)
7. Replace multi-display
8. Replace radio receiver assy
9. Replace multi-display controller
sub-assy
05-1828
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display radio receiver assy) *6
3. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
4. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
5. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display
controller sub-assy-radio receiver assy)
6. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display
controller sub-assy-multi-display)
7. Replace multi-display
8. Replace radio receiver assy
9. Replace multi-display controller
sub-assy
05-1828
When ”Registration complete” command from the
master device cannot be received.
This code will be detected when signal receiving time is delayed.
When the AMP device records that the AMP output does not function even while the source device operates.
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display radio receiver assy) *6
3. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
4. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
5. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display
controller sub-assy-radio receiver assy)
6. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display
controller sub-assy-multi-display)
7. Replace multi-display
8. Replace radio receiver assy
9. Replace multi-display controller
sub-assy
When the command for ON/OFF control from the
master device has a problem.
Replace multi-display
05-1866
05-1832
05-1836
05-1864
05-1858
67-8
67-6
67-23
05-1866
05-1832
05-1836
05-1864
05-1858
67-8
67-6
67-23
05-1828
05-1866
05-1832
05-1836
05-1864
05-1858
67-8
67-6
67-23
67-8
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1986
05-1797
DIAGNOSTICS
E3
*1
Registration demand
transmission
E4
Multiple frame incomplete
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
When the registration demand command from the
slave device is output, or when the registration
demand command is output by receiving connection confirmation command from the sub master
device.
-
-
When the multiple frame transmission ends incompletely
-
-
Verification
See page
*6: w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
(b) Logical address: 01 (Communication control)
DTC
Name
Diagnosis
D5
*1
*5
Absence of registration unit
A device that the sub code shows is (was) disconnected from the system when turning the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position.
The communication condition with the device that
the code shows cannot be obtained when the engine starts.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
D8
*2
*5
No response for connection
check
The device indicated by the sub code is (was)
disconnected from the system after engine start
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
D9
*1
*5
Last mode error
The device (for audio visual system) that had
functioned before the engine stopped is (was)
disconnected from the system when the ignition
switch is (was) in the ACC or ON position.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
DA
*5
No response against ON/OFF
command
No response is identified when changing mode
(audio and visual mode change). Detected when
sound and image do not change by switch operation.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
This code detects a dual alarm.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
This code indicates a transmission failure to the
device indicated by the sub code.
NOTE: This DTC may have no direct relationship
with the malfunction.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
Inspection for the device indicated
This code is stored when a slave device has been by the sub code.
disconnected after engine start.
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code.)
Refer to
step 6
DB
*1
*5
DC
*3
*5
DE
*4
*5
Mode status error
Failure in transmission
Slave reset
HINT:
*1: This code may be recorded depending on the battery condition or engine start voltage even if no
failure is detected.
*2: If the power connector is disconnected after the engine starts, this code is recorded after 180 seconds.
*3: This code may be stored if the ignition key is turned to the START position again with the engine
running.
*4: This code may be stored if the ignition key is held in the START position for 1 minute or more before
returning to the ON position.
*5: If the device is reported as not existing during verification, check the power source circuit and AVCLAN circuit for the device.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1987
05-1798
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(c) Logical address: 62 (CD): 63 (CD changer)
HINT:
Methods used to verify the cause of the problem are listed in order of probability in the verification column.
DTC
Name
10
CD player mechanical error
11
CD insertion & eject error
12
CD reading abnormal
40
No disc
Diagnosis
Verification
See page
A mechanical error in the CD player is detected
while the CD is not being inserted or ejected.
Replace radio receiver assy
67-6
CD insertion or ejection is failed.
Replace radio receiver assy
67-6
CD reading problem occurs.
Replace radio receiver assy
67-6
67-6
No disc is inserted.
1. Check whether the CD is inserted or not. If the CD is inserted, check whether it can be
ejected or not. If it cannot be
ejected, replace radio receiver
assy.
2. Inspect CD
3. If the same code is detected, replace the radio receiver assy
05-1682
67-6
An unsuitable disc is inserted.
1. Inspect CD
2. If the same code is detected, replace the radio receiver assy
05-1682
67-6
Disc cannot be read
The disc cannot be read.
1. Inspect CD
2. If the same code is detected, replace the radio receiver assy
05-1682
67-6
CD-ROM abnormal
CD-ROM operation is abnormal.
Replace radio receiver assy
1. After clearing the DTC, check
the malfunction symptom
2. If the same code is detected, replace the radio receiver assy
41
Wrong disc
42
43
67-6
-
44
CD abnormal
Operation error in the CD mechanism (except for
code 10).
45
EJECT error
Magazine cannot be ejected.
Replace radio receiver assy
46
Disc has scratches in the
reverse surface
CD has dirt or scratches in the reverse side.
1. Inspect CD
2. If the same code is detected, replace the radio receiver assy
05-1682
67-6
-
The sensor detects that the CD unit temperature
is high.
1. Park the vehicle in a cool place.
Turn the engine off. After checking that the temperature of the
radio and navigation assy becomes sufficiently low, turn the
engine on in order to verify the
malfunction symptom.
2. If the same code is detected, replace the radio receiver assy
47
CD temperature is high
48
Excess current
50
Tray insertion/ejection error
51
Elevator error
52
Clamp error
67-6
67-6
67-6
Excess current is applied to disc player changer.
Replace radio receiver assy
67-6
Malfunction in insertion/ejection system
Replace radio receiver assy
67-6
Mechanical error occurred during elevator operation
Replace radio receiver assy
67-6
Clamp unusually generating
Replace radio receiver assy
67-6
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1988
05-1799
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(d) Logical address: 61 (Cassette)
HINT:
Methods used to verify the cause of the problem are listed in order of probability in the verification column.
DTC
Name
10
Belt cut
40
Mechanical error of media
Diagnosis
Verification
The inside belt is cut or came off.
Replace radio receiver assy
A malfunction due to mechanical problem, cassette tape is cut or entangled.
1. Replace the cassette tape and
recheck the symptom
2. If the same code is detected, replace the radio receiver assy
See page
67-6
67-6
41
EJECT error
A malfunction due to mechanical problem.
Replace radio receiver assy
67-6
42
Tape tangling
Cassette tape is tangled.
Replace radio receiver assy
67-6
Head is dirty.
1. Clean the head and recheck the
symptom
2. If the same code is detected, replace the radio receiver assy
A short or open in the power circuit.
1. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
2. Replace radio receiver assy
43
Head dirt
44
Device power supply problem
67-6
05-1832
67-6
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1989
05-1800
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4.
MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY (Physical address: 1F6, 16C, 16D) [RSE ECU]
(a) Logical address: 01 (Communication control)
HINT:
Methods used to verify the cause of the problem are listed in order of probability in the verification column.
DTC
D6
*1
D7
DC
*2
*5
DD
*3
DF
*4
E0
*1
Name
No master
Connection check error
Transmission error
Master reset
Master error
Registration complete indication
error
Diagnosis
Verification
See page
05-1828
When either of the following conditions meets.
The device that stores (stored) the code has
(had) been disconnected when the ignition
switch is (was) in ACC or ON position.
The master device has (had) been disconnected
when this code is (was) stored.
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display multi-display controller subassy)
3. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
4. Replace multi-display
5. Replace multi-display controller
sub-assy
05-1828
When either of the following conditions meets.
The device that stored this code has (had) been
disconnected after the engine starts (started).
The master device has (had) been disconnected
when this code is (was) stored.
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display multi-display controller subassy)
3. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
4. Replace multi-display
5. Replace multi-display controller
sub-assy
05-1858
05-1836
67-8
67-23
05-1858
05-1836
67-8
67-23
The device stores the fact that transmission to the
device indicated by the sub code has failed.
Inspection for the device indicated
by the sub code
(Refer to the inspection list for the
device indicated by the sub code)
05-1828
When the device that should be the master has
been disconnected after engine starts.
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display multi-display controller subassy)
3. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
4. Replace multi-display
5. Replace multi-display controller
sub-assy
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display multi-display controller subassy)
3. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
4. Replace multi-display
5. Replace multi-display controller
sub-assy
05-1828
When the device with a display fails and the master is switched to the audio device.
Also when a communication error between sub
master (audio) and master occurs, this code is
stored.
When ”Registration complete” command from the
master device cannot be received.
This code is detected when signal
receiving time is delayed.
Refer to
step 6
05-1858
05-1836
67-8
67-23
05-1858
05-1836
67-8
67-23
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1990
05-1801
DIAGNOSTICS
E1
*1
Voice processing device ON
error
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
When the AMP device records that the AMP output does not function even while the source device operates.
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display multi-display controller subassy)
3. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
4. Replace multi-display
5. Replace multi-display controller
sub-assy
05-1828
05-1858
05-1836
67-8
67-23
ON/OFF indication parameter
error
When the command for ON/OFF control from the
master device has a problem.
E3
*1
Registration demand
transmission
When the registration demand command from the
slave device is output, or when the registration
demand command is output by receiving connection confirmation command from the sub master
device.
-
-
E4
Multiple frame incomplete
When the multiple frame transmission ends incomplete
-
-
21
ROM error
This code is output when a malfunction exists in
ROM.
Replace multi-display
67-8
22
RAM error
This code is output when a malfunction exists in
RAM.
Replace multi-display
67-8
E2
Replace multi-display
67-8
HINT:
*1: This code may be recorded depending on the battery condition or engine start voltage even if no
failure is detected.
*2: If the power connector is disconnected after the engine starts, this code is recorded after 180 seconds.
*3: This code may be stored if the ignition key is turned to the START position again with the engine
running.
*4: This code may be stored if the ignition key is held in the START position for 1 minute or more before
returning to the ON position.
*5: If the device is reported as not existing during verification, check the power source circuit and AVCLAN circuit for the device.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1991
05-1802
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
5.
GATEWAY ECU (Physical address: 1C6) [G/W]
(a) Logical address: 01 (Communication control)
HINT:
Methods used to verify the cause of the problem are listed in order of probability in the verification column.
DTC
D4
Name
Diagnosis
Regular Communication Error
Component in which this code is recorded has
been disconnected from system with ignition in
the ACC or ON position. Either that, or the multidisplay was disconnected when this code was
recorded.
Verification
See page
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display gateway ECU)
3. Power source circuit (gateway
ECU)
4. Replace multi-display
5. Replace gateway ECU
05-1828
05-1862
05-1834
67-8
67-21
HINT:
This code is stored 210 seconds after the power supply connector of the master component is disconnected
with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position.
6.
THE INSPECTION LIST FOR THE DEVICE INDICATED BY THE SUB CODE
HINT:
Methods used to verify the cause of the problem are listed in order of probability in the verification column.
Sub code address
(Device name)
110
(Multi-display)
178
(Navigation ECU)
190
(Radio receiver assy)
IF6, 16C, 16D
(Multi-display controller
sub-assy)
1C6
(Gateway ECU)
Verification
See page
1. Power source circuit (multi-display)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display - radio receiver assy) *1
3. Replace multi-display
05-1828
05-1866
67-8
1. Power source circuit (navigation ECU)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display - navigation ECU)
3. Replace navigation ECU
05-1830
05-1860
67-9
1. Power source circuit (radio receiver assy)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy - radio receiver assy) *2
3. Replace radio receiver assy
05-1832
05-1864
67-6
1. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy) *2
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy - multi-display) *2
3. Replace multi-display controller sub-assy *2
05-1836
05-1858
67-23
1. Power source circuit (gateway ECU)
2. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display - gateway ECU)
3. Replace gateway ECU
05-1834
05-1862
67-21
*1: w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
*2: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1992
05-1757
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05IRX-02
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
1
Vehicle brought into a workshop
2
Diagnostic questioning and symptom confirmation (SEE PAGE 05-1759 )
Ask the customer about symptoms and confirm malfunctions. Fill out the Customer Problem Analysis check
sheet.
The screen displays nothing (GO TO STEP 7,
proceed to ”BLACK SCREEN (NO IMAGE APPEARS ON NAVIGATION/AUDIO SCREEN)”)
Other symptoms (GO TO STEP 3)
3
Check multiplex communication system (SEE PAGE 05-2040 )
Use the hand-held tester to check for normal function of the body multiplex communication system.
A code is output (PROCEED TO ”BODY MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM”)
A code is not output (GO TO STEP 4)
4
Confirm the system normal condition (SEE PAGE 05-1775 )
Applicable (This is not a malfunction.)
Not applicable (GO TO STEP 5)
5
Check the diagnostic trouble codes (SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
HINT:
If the system cannot enter the diagnosis mode, inspect each AVC-LAN communication signal and repair or replace problem parts (see page 05-1828 - 05-1866 ).
Even if the malfunction symptom is not confirmed, check the diagnostic trouble codes. This is because
the system stores past diagnostic trouble codes.
Refer to the detailed description on the diagnostic screen, as necessary (see page 05-1768 ).
Check and clear the past diagnostic trouble code. Check the diagnostic trouble code and inspect the
area the code indicates.
A code is output (GO TO STEP 6)
A code is not output (GO TO STEP 7)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1947
05-1758
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Diagnostic trouble code chart (SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
Find the output code on the diagnostic trouble code chart.
Output the diagnostic trouble code (GO TO
STEP 9)
7
Problem symptoms table (SEE PAGE 05-1778 )
Find the applicable symptom code in the problem symptoms table.
HINT:
If the symptom does not recur and no code is output, perform the symptom reproduction method (see page
01-26 ).
There is an applicable symptom code in the
table (GO TO STEP 9)
There is no applicable symptom code in the
table (GO TO STEP 8)
8
Check the ECU terminal arrangement based on the malfunction symptom (SEE
PAGE 05-1780 )
9
Check the circuit
Adjust, repair or replace as necessary.
10
Recheck the diagnostic trouble code (SEE PAGE 05-1791 )
HINT:
After deleting the DTC, recheck the diagnostic trouble code.
Perform the screen noise adjustment when the multi-display or the navigation ECU is replaced (see
page 05-1803 ).
11
Perform confirmation test
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1948
05-1750
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05CE7-07
LOCATION
Engine Room J/B
Engine Room R/B
Fusible Link Block
CRT Fuse
DOME Fuse
ALT Fuse
RAD No.1 Fuse
Front No.2 Speaker Assy
Park/Neutral
Position Switch
Assy
*2
Front No.1 Speaker Assy
*1
Navigation ECU
Multi-display
Controller Sub-assy
Combination Meter Assy
Center J/B
Multi-display
GPS Antenna
Gateway ECU
Passenger
Side J/B
Parking Brake
Switch
Instrument
Panel J/B
ECU-IG Fuse
RAD No.2 Fuse
AM1 Fuse
IGN Fuse
PANEL Fuse
TAIL LIGHT Relay
Radio Receiver Assy
*1: w/ 3rd Seat, w/ RSE
*2: w/ 2rd Seat, w/ RSE
I40210
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1940
05-1780
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
05CEE-06
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
MULTI-DISPLA Y ASSY:
M5
M4
M3
I40205
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
G - W-B
Illumination (rheostat)
signal
Turn light control switch
OFF → TAIL or HEAD
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
B - Body ground
Illumination (rheostat)
signal
Turn light control switch
OFF → TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
GND1 (M3-3) - Body ground
W-B Body ground
Ground
TX1+ (M3-4) - GND1 (M3-3)
SB - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
TX1- (M3-5) - GND1 (M3-3)
BR - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
TC (M3-7) - GND1 (M3-3)
P - W-B
Diagnosis ON signal
Ignition switch to OFF and connect
terminals TC and GND1 of check
connector
IG (M3-10) - GND1 (M3-3)
O - W-B
Ignition (ON)
ACC (M3-11) - GND1 (M3-3)
BR - W-B
Accessory (ON)
+B1 (M3-12) - GND1 (M3-3)
V - W-B
Battery
PKB (M3-16) - GND1 (M3-3)
Y - W-B
Parking brake signal
SPD (M3-25) - GND1 (M3-3)
W - W-B
Speed signal from combination meter
TX3+ (M4-11) -GND1 (M3-3)
BR - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
TX3- (M4-12) - GND1 (M3-3)
L - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
TX+ (M4-13) GND1 (M3-3) *1
LG - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
TX- (M4-14) GND1 (M3-3) *1
O - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
VR (M4-23) - GND1 (M3-3)
B - W-B
Video return signal
Turn ignition switch OFF
Below 1 V
R (M4-24) - GND1 (M3-3)
W - W-B
Display signal (red)
Navigation display is on
-
G (M4-25) - GND1 (M3-3)
R - W-B
Display signal (green)
Navigation display is on
-
B (M4-26) - GND1 (M3-3)
G - W-B
Display signal (blue)
Navigation display is on
-
Y - W-B
Display signal
(synchronize)
Navigation display is on
-
ILL+ (M3-1) - GND1 (M3-3)
ILL- (M3-2) - Body ground
SYNC (M4-27) - GND1 (M3-3)
Always
Below 1 V
Below 1 Ω
Turn ignition switch OFF → ON
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
Turn ignition switch
OFF → ACC or ON
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
Always
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
Turn parking brake switch
ON → OFF
See ”vehicle signal check mode”
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1970
05-1781
DIAGNOSTICS
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Shielded Body ground
Shielded ground
NTSC (M5-1) GND1 (M3-3) *1
G - W-B
Display signal
SGD1 (M5-4) Body ground *1
R - Body ground
Shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
SGND (M5-5) Body ground *1
Shielded Body ground
Shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
VG (M4-28) - Body ground
Always
Below 1 V
DVD is playing on multi-display
-
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
2.
NAVIGATION ECU:
N3
N4
I40206
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
AUI+ (N3-1) - GND1 (N3-17)
LG - W-B
Sound signal (input)
Audio system is playing
-
AUO+ (N3- 2) - GND1 (N3-17)
G - W-B
Sound signal (output)
Audio system is playing
-
SPD (N3-5) - GND1 (N3-17)
O - W-B
Speed signal from
combination meter
See ”Vehicle Signal Check Mode”
(see page 05-1763 )
-
+B (N3-9) - GND1 (N3-17)
W - W-B
Battery
AUI- (N3-10) - GND1 (N3-17)
R - W-B
Sound signal (input)
Audio system is playing
-
AUO- (N3-11) GND1 (N3-17)
B - W-B
Sound signal (output)
Audio system is playing
-
RL (N3-14) - GND1 (N3-17)
Y - W-B
park/neutral position
switch
GND1 (N3-17) - Body ground
W-B Body ground
Ground
ACC (N3-18) - GND1 (N3-17)
GR - W-B
Accessory (ON)
VR (N4-1) - GND1 (N3-17)
B - W-B
Video return signal
Turn ignition switch OFF
Below 1 V
R (N4-2) - GND1 (N3-17)
W - W-B
Display signal (red)
Navigation display is on
-
B (N4-3) - GND1 (N3-17)
G - W-B
Display signal (blue)
Navigation display is on
-
TX+ (N4-5) - GND1 (N3-17)
SB - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
VG (N4-6) - Body ground
Shielded Body ground
Shielded ground
G (N4-7) - GND1 (N3-17)
R - W-B
Display signal (green)
Navigation display is on
-
SYNC (N4-8) - GND1 (N3-17)
Y - W-B
Display signal
(synchronize)
Navigation display is on
-
TX- (N4-10) - GND1 (N3-17)
BR - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Reverse signal from
Specification
Always
10 to 14 V
Park/neutral position switch is ”R”
position
10 to 14 V
Always
Below 1 V
Turn ignition switch OFF →
ACC or ON
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
2 to 3 V
Always
Below 1 V
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1971
05-1782
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
RADIO RECEIVER ASSY:
R4
R22
R23
I40207
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
B (R4-1) - GND (R4-20)
Symbols (Terminal No.)
L-B - BR
Battery
Condition
Specification
ACC (R4-11) - GND (R4-20)
GR - BR
Accessory (ON)
GND (R4-20) - Body ground
BR - Body
ground
Ground
TX+ (R22-9) GND (R4-20) *2
LG - BR
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
TX- (R22-10) GND (R4-20) *2
O - BR
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
TX1+ (R23-9) GND (R4-20) *1
Y - BR
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
TX1- (R23-10) GND (R4-20) *1
L - BR
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
Always
10 to 14 V
Turn ignition switch OFF →
ACC or ON
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
Always
Below 1 V
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
*2: w/o Rear Seat Entertainment System
4.
GATEWAY ECU
G5
I40209
Symbols (Terminal No.)
IG (G5-2) - GND (G5-14)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
Turn ignition switch OFF → ON
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
B - W-B
Ignition (ON)
BR - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
W-B Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
BATT (G5-8) - GND (G5-14)
LG - W-B
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC (G5-9) - GND (G5-14)
SB - W-B
Accessory (ON)
Turn ignition switch OFF →
ACC or ON
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
L - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
W-B Body ground
Ground
GTX+ (G5-5) - GND (G5-14)
CG (G5-7) - Body ground
GTX- (G5-12) - GND (G5-14)
GND (G5-14) - Body ground
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
Below 1 Ω
Always
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1972
05-1783
DIAGNOSTICS
5.
-
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
MULTI DISPLAY CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY:
R31
R29
I40208
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
+B1 (R29-16) GND (R29-29) *1
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Y - W-B
Battery
TX3+ (R29-17) GND (R29-29)
BR - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
TX3- (R29-18) GND (R29-29)
Y - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
W-B Body ground
Ground
TX- (R29-30) GND (R29-29) *1
GR - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
TX+ (R29-31) GND (R29-29) *1
LG - W-B
AVC-LAN
communication signal
Turn ignition switch to ACC
2 to 3 V
ACC (R29-32) GND (R29-29)
G - W-B
Accessory (ON)
Turn ignition switch OFF →
ACC or ON
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V
W-B Body ground
Ground
GND (R29-29) - Body ground
SELD (R31-7) - Body ground
Condition
Specification
Always
10 to 14 V
Always
Below 1 V
Always
Below 1 V
*1: w/ Rear Seat Entertainment System
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1973
05-1028
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EK3-06
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
1.
DTC CHECK (CHECK MODE)
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
Compared to the normal mode, the check mode has more sensing ability to detect malfunctions. Furthermore, the same diagnostic items which are detected in the normal mode can also be
detected in the check mode.
Hand-Held Tester
DLC3
G30830
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR3904
(a)
Procedure for Check Mode using the hand-held tester.
(1) Check the initial conditions.
Battery positive voltage 11 V or more
Throttle valve fully closed
Transaxle in the P or N position
A/C switch is off
(2) Turn the ignition switch off.
(3) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(4) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push
the hand-held tester main switch on.
(5) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/
CHECK MODE” (Check that the MIL flashes).
NOTICE:
All DTCs and freeze frame data recorded will be erased if:
1) the hand-held tester is used to change the ECM from
normal mode to check mode or vice-versa; or 2) during
check mode, the ignition switch is turned from ON to ACC
or OFF.
(6) Start the engine (MIL goes off after the engine
starts).
(7) Perform ”MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN” for the ECT
test (see page 05-1014 ).
(Or, simulate the conditions of the malfunction described by the customer).
NOTICE:
Leave the ignition switch in the ON position until you have
checked the DTCs, etc.
(8) After simulating malfunction conditions, use the
hand-held tester diagnosis selector to check the
DTCs and freeze frame data, etc.
(9) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/
DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(10) After checking the DTC, inspect the applicable circuit.
(11) See page 05-1034 to confirm the details of the
DTCs.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1218
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1029
DTC CLEAR
When using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester:
Clearing the DTCs.
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester
to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push
the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch on.
(3) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/
DTC INFO/CLEAR CODES [YES] button”.
HINT:
When operating the OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or hand-held tester to erase the codes, the DTCs and
freeze frame data will be erased. (See the OBD II scan tool’s
instruction book for operating instructions.)
(b) When not using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester:
Clearing the DTCs.
(1) Disconnecting the battery terminal or remove the
EFI and ETCS fuses from the engine room J/B for
60 seconds or more. But if you disconnect the battery terminal, you should do the ”INITIALIZE” procedure.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1219
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-987
05EK7-06
DEFINITION OF TERMS
Term
Definition
Monitor description
Description of what the ECM monitors and how it detects malfunctions (monitoring purpose and its details).
Related DTCs
A group of diagnostic trouble codes that are output by the ECM based on the same malfunction detection logic.
Typical enabling condition
Preconditions that allow the ECM to detect malfunctions.
With all preconditions satisfied, the ECM sets the DTC when the monitored value(s) exceeds the malfunction
threshold(s).
Sequence of operation
The priority order that is applied to monitoring, if multiple sensors and components are used to detect the malfunction.
While another sensor is being monitored, the next sensor or component will not be monitored until the previous
monitoring has concluded.
Required sensor/components
The sensors and components that are used by the ECM to detect malfunctions.
Frequency of operation
The number of times that the ECM checks for malfunctions per driving cycle.
”Once per driving cycle” means that the ECM detects malfunction only one time during a single driving cycle.
”Continuous” means that the ECM detects malfunction every time when enabling condition is met.
Duration
The minimum time that the ECM must sense a continuous deviation in the monitored value(s) before setting a
DTC. This timing begins after the ”typical enabling conditions” are met.
Malfunction thresholds
Beyond this value, the ECM will conclude that there is a malfunction and set a DTC.
MIL operation
MIL illumination timing after a defect is detected.
”Immediately” means that the ECM illuminates MIL the instant the ECM determines that there is a malfunction.
”2 driving cycle” means that the ECM illuminates MIL if the same malfunction is detected again in the 2nd driving
cycle.
Component operating range
Normal operation range of sensors and solenoids under normal driving conditions.
Use these ranges as a reference.
They cannot be used to judge if a sensor or solenoid is defective or not.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1177
05-1024
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EK0-05
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
(a)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Description
(1) When troubleshooting OBD II vehicles, the only difference from the usual troubleshooting procedure
is that you need to connect an OBD II scan tool complying with SAE J1987 or a hand-held tester to the
vehicle, and read off various data output from the
vehicle’s ECM.
(2)
FI0534
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle’s onboard computer illuminate the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer detects a malfunction in the computer itself or
in the drive system components which affect the vehicle emissions. In addition to the MIL illuminating
when a malfunction is detected, the applicable
DTCs prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the
ECM memory (see page 05-1034 ).
If the malfunction does not occur in 3 consecutive trips, the MIL
goes off but the DTCs remain in the ECM memory.
(3) To check the DTCs, connect the OBD II scan tool or
hand-held tester to the DLC3 of the vehicle. The
OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester also enables
you to erase the DTCs and check freeze frame data
and various forms of engine data (For instruction
book).
(4) The DTCs include SAE controlled codes and
Manufacturer controlled codes. SAE controlled
codes must be set as prescribed by the SAE, while
Manufacturer controlled codes can be set freely by
a manufacturer within the prescribed limits (see the
DTC chart on page 05-1034 ).
(5) The diagnosis system operates in the normal mode
during the normal vehicle use, and also has a check
mode for technicians to simulate malfunction symptoms and perform troubleshooting. Most DTCs use
2 trip detection logic(*) to prevent erroneous detection. By switching the ECM to the check mode when
troubleshooting, the technician can cause the MIL
to illuminate for a malfunction that is only detected
once or momentarily (hand-held tester).
(6) *2 trip detection logic:
When a malfunction is first detected, the malfunction is temporarily stored in the ECM memory. If the
same malfunction is detected again during the second test drive, this second detection causes the
MIL to illuminate.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1214
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
D1
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1025
Inspect the DLC3.
The vehicle’s ECM uses ISO 9141-2 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of DLC3 complies with SAE
J1962 and matches the ISO 9141-2 format.
1 23 4 5 6 78
9 10111213141516
DLC3
A04550
Tester connection
7 (Bus Line) - 5 (Signal ground)
Condition
Specified condition
During communication
Pulse generation
4 (Chassis Ground) - Body
Always
1 Ω or less
5 (Signal Ground) - Body
Always
1 Ω or less
16 (B+) - Body
Always
9 to 14 V
HINT:
If your display shows UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE
when you have connected the cable of the OBD II scan tool or
hand-held tester to the DLC3, turned the ignition switch to the
ON position and operated the scan tool, there is a problem on
the vehicle side or tool side.
If the communication is normal when the tool is connected
to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on the original vehicle.
If the communication is still impossible when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in
the tool itself, so consult the Service Department listed in
the tool’s instruction manual.
(c) Measure the battery voltage.
Battery Voltage: 11 to 14 V
If voltage is below 11 V, recharge the battery before proceeding.
(d) Check the MIL.
(1) The MIL comes on when the ignition switch is turned
to the ON position and the engine is not running.
HINT:
If the MIL does not light up, troubleshoot the combination meter.
(2) When the engine is started, the MIL should go off.
If the lamp remains on, it means that the diagnosis
system has detected a malfunction or abnormality
in the system.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1215
05-1032
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EK5-07
DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST
1.
DATA LIST
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Push the ”ON” button of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
(f)
When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST”.
(g) According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Item
Measurement Item/
Range (display)
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light SW Status/
ON or OFF
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Brake Pedal is depressed: ON
Brake Pedal is released: OFF
-
PNP SW [NSW]
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
P and N: ON
Except P and N: OFF
When the shift lever position displayed on the hand-held tester differs from the actual position, adjustment of the PNP switch or the
shift cable may be incorrect.
HINT:
When the failure still occurs even
after adjusting these parts,
see page 05-1036 .
LOW
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
L: ON
Except L: OFF
↑
2ND
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
2 and L: ON
Except 2 and L: OFF
↑
REVERSE
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
R: ON
Except R: OFF
↑
DRIVE
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
D: ON
Except D: OFF
↑
O/D SW Status/
ON or OFF
IG SW ON: ON
↓
O/D SW Push: OFF
↓
O/D SW Push: ON
-
Shift lever position is;
L: 1st
2: 1st or 2nd
3: 1st, 2nd or 3rd
D(O/D OFF): 1st, 2nd, 3rd or 4th
D(O/D ON): 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th or
5th
-
OVERDRV CUT SW2
SHIFT
Actual Gear Position/
1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th or 5th (O/D)
LOCK UP SOL
Lock Up Solenoid Status/
ON or OFF
Lock Up: ON
Except Lock Up: OFF
-
SOLENOID (SLT)
Shift Solenoid SLT Status/
ON or OFF
Accelerator pedal is depressed:
OFF
Accelerator pedal is released:
ON
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1222
DIAGNOSTICS
AT FLUID TEMP
SPD (NC)
ATF Temp. Sensor Value/
min.: -40C (-40F)
max.: 215C (419F)
Counter Gear Speed/
display: 50 r/min
-
05-1033
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
After Stall Test;
Approx. 80C (176F)
Equal to ambient temperature
when the engine is cold
If the value is ”-40C (-40F)” or
”215C (419F)”, ATF temp. sensor circuit is opened or shorted.
[HINT]
3rd when shift lever position is D
position (After warming up the engine);
Intermediate shaft speed (NC)
becomes close to the engine
speed.
-
2.
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method
to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Push the ”ON” button of the hand-held tester.
(f)
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/ACTIVE TEST”.
(g) According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SHIFT
[Test Details]
Operate the shift solenoid valve and set the each shift position by yourself.
[Vehicle Condition]
Less than 50 km/h (31 mph)
[Others]
Press ”→” button: Shift up
Press ”←” button: Shift down
Possible to check the operation of
the shift solenoid valves.
[Test Details]
Control the shift solenoid DSL to set the automatic transaxle to the
lock-up condition.
[Vehicle Condition]
Vehicle Speed: 60 km/h (37 mph) or more, and 5th gear
Possible to check the DSL operation.
LOCK UP
LINE PRESS UP *
[Test Details]
Operate the shift solenoid SLT and raise the line pressure.
[Vehicle Condition]
Vehicle Stopped.
IDL: ON
[HINT]
OFF: Line pressure up (When the active test of ”LINE PRESS UP” is
performed, the ECM commands the SLT solenoid to turn off).
ON: No action (normal operation)
-
*: ”LINE PRESS UP” in the ACTIVE TEST is performed to check the line pressure changes by connecting
the SST to the automatic transaxle, which is used in the HYDRAULIC TEST (see page 05-1002 ) as well.
HINT:
The pressure values in ACTIVE TEST and HYDRAULIC TEST are different from each other.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1223
05-1026
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EK1-06
DTC CHECK/CLEAR
1.
DTC CHECK (NORMAL MODE)
NOTICE:
When the diagnostic system is switched from the normal
mode to the check mode, all the DTCs and freeze frame
data recorded in the normal mode will be erased. So before
switching modes, always check the DTCs and freeze frame
data, and note them down.
Hand-Held Tester
DLC3
G30830
(a)
Checking DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held
tester.
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester
to DLC3.
(3) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push
the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch on.
(4) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/
DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(5) Use the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to
check the DTCs and freeze frame data and note
them down (For operating instructions, see the
OBD II scan tool’s instruction book).
(6) See page 05-1034 to confirm the details of the
DTCs.
NOTICE:
When simulating symptoms with an OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester) to check the DTCs, use the normal mode. For codes on the DTCs chart subject to ”2 trip
detection logic”, turn the ignition switch off after the symptom is simulated once. Then repeat the simulation process
again. When the problem has been simulated twice, the MIL
is indicated on the instrument panel and DTCs are recorded in the ECM.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1216
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1027
DTC CLEAR
When using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester:
Clearing the DTCs.
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester
to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push
the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch on.
(3) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/
DTC INFO/CLEAR CODES [YES] button”.
HINT:
When operating the OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or hand-held tester to erase the codes, the DTCs and
freeze frame data will be erased. (See the OBD II scan tool’s
instruction book for operating instructions.)
(b) When not using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester:
Clearing the DTCs.
(1) Disconnecting the battery terminal or remove the
EFI and ETCS fuses from the engine room J/B for
60 seconds or more. But if you disconnect the battery terminal, you should do the ”INITIALIZE” procedure.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1217
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1 111
05ITF-02
PATTERN SELECT SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Multiplex network body ECU receives pattern select switch information, and sends it through the multiplex
communication system to the ECM.
ECT SNOW is the system that operates the throttle motor to control engine output to reduce skidding of the
driving wheels, guarantee takeoff acceleration, driving straightness and turning stability.
WIRING DIAGRAM
E4
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Pattern Select SW *
Center J/B
W-B
13
3F
8
3D
W-B
Y
4
3
Multiplex Network
Body ECU
15
B9 SNOW
IB
(*) Pattern Select Switch (ECT SNOW Switch)
When the ECT SNOW switch is pushed, the switch contact is made and the ECT SNOW mode is selected.
To cancel the ECT SNOW mode, push the ECT SNOW switch once again. The ECT SNOW mode is automatically cancelled when the ignition switch is turned ”OFF”.
G30835
G32449
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1301
05-1 112
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
DRIVING TEST
Start the engine.
Turn the ECT SNOW switch ”OFF” (Normal drive mode).
Confirm vehicle response by driving from a parked position to fully depressing the accelerator pedal.
Turn the ECT SNOW switch ”ON” and perform the same check as (c).
Confirm that there is a difference between ECT SNOW switch ”ON” and ”OFF”.
HINT:
Driving test should be done on a paved road (a nonskid road).
Make sure not to use the TRAC system when testing a vehicle equipped with one.
OK:
There is a difference in acceleration between ”ON” and ”OFF”.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1016 )
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PATTERN SELECT SWITCH ASSY NO.1 BODY GROUND)
(a)
Wire Harness Side:
(Connector Front View):
(b)
Disconnect the connector of pattern select switch (ECT
SNOW switch).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
E4
NG
G23382
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
4 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
3
INSPECT PATTERN SELECT SWITCH ASSY NO.1
(a)
Switch Side:
(Connector Front View):
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Switch Condition
E4
Tester Connection
Press continuously
Pattern select switch
Below 1 Ω
3-4
Release
Pattern select switch
C82813
Specified Condition
D25463
NG
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE PATTERN SELECT SWITCH ASSY
NO.1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1302
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
05-1 113
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PATTERN SELECT SWITCH ASSY NO.1 MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Connect the connector of pattern select switch (ECT
SNOW switch).
Disconnect the multiplex network body ECU connector.
Measure the resistance between terminals SNOW of multiplex network body ECU and body ground.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Press continuously
Pattern select switch
Release
Pattern select switch
Multiplex Network Body ECU:
Back Side:
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
B9 - 15 (SNOW) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
B9
B9
SNOW
G32072
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1016 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1303
05-1030
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EK2-05
FAIL-SAFE CHART
1.
FAIL-SAFE
This function minimizes the loss of the ECT functions when any malfunction occurs in each sensor or solenoid.
(a) ATF (Automatic Transmission Fluid) temperature sensor:
When the ATF temperature sensor has a malfunction, 5th upshift is prohibited.
(b) Counter gear speed sensor NC (Speed sensor NC):
When the counter gear speed sensor has a malfunction, 5th upshift is prohibited.
(c) Shift solenoid valve DSL:
When the solenoid valve DSL has a malfunction, the current to the solenoid valve is stopped.
This stops lock-up control, then fuel economy decreases.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1220
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-1031
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
(d) Shift solenoid valve SL1, SL2, SL3 and S4:
Fail safe function:
If either of the shift solenoid valve circuits develops an open or short, the ECM turns the other shift solenoid
”ON” and ”OFF” in order to shift into the gear positions shown in the table below.
Manual shifting as shown in the following table must be done (In case of a short circuit, the ECM stops sending the current to the short circuit solenoid).
Even if starting the engine in the fail-safe mode, the gear position remain in the same position.
: ON
: According to Flex Lock-up
: OFF
: Condition in the normal operation is shown on the left of ” ”.
Condition in the fail-safe mode is shown on the right of ” ”.
Normal
Solenoid
Valve
SL1
SL2
SL3
S4
Gear Position
SL1 Malfunction
(During driving at 1st
or 2nd)
Solenoid
Valve
1st
SL1 Malfunction
(During driving at 3rd)
Solenoid
Valve
Solenoid
Valve
SL3 Malfunction
1st
2nd
1st
4th 2nd
4th 3rd
4th
1st
4th 2nd
4th 3rd
1st
4th 2nd
4th 3rd
Solenoid
Valve
Solenoid
Valve
Gear Position
2nd 4th
2nd 5th
2nd
4th
5th
4th
4th
4th
5th
4th
4th
4th
5th
4th
1st
2nd
3rd
4th
5th
4th
1st
2nd
3rd
4th
5th
4th
4th
5th
4th
SL1
SL2
SL3
S4
Gear Position
SL1, SL2, SL3, and S4
Malfunction
3rd
SL1
SL2
SL3
S4
Gear Position
S4 Malfunction
2nd
SL1
SL2
SL3
S4
Gear Position
Solenoid
Valve
5th
SL1
SL2
SL3
S4
Gear Position
SL2 Malfunction
4th
SL1
SL2
SL3
S4
Gear Position
SL1 Malfunction
(During driving at 4th
or 5th)
3rd
SL1
SL2
SL3
S4
Gear Position
Solenoid
Valve
2nd
SL1
SL2
SL3
S4
1st
4th 2nd
4th 3rd
4th
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1221
05-1002
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EJX-05
HYDRAULIC TEST
Test Plug A:
D Position (CO)
SST
Test Plug B:
R Position (C2)
SST
G30832
1.
PERFORM HYDRAULIC TEST
(a) Measure the line pressure.
NOTICE:
Perform the test at the normal operation fluid temperature the 50 to 80°C (122 to 176°F)
The line pressure test should always be carried out in
pairs. One technician should observe the conditions
of wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while
the other is performing the test.
Be careful to prevent SST hose from interfering with
the exhaust pipe.
This check must be conducted after checking and adjusting engine.
Perform under condition that A/C is OFF.
When conducting stall test, do not continue more
than 10 seconds.
(1) Warm up the ATF (Automatic Transmission Fluid).
(2) Lift the vehicle up.
(3) Remove the engine under cover.
(4) Connect hand-held tester to DLC3.
(5) Remove the test plug A on the transaxle case front
left side and install the SST.
SST 09992-00095 (09992- 00231, 09992-00271)
NOTICE:
There is a difference in installation point between D position and R position.
(6) Start the engine.
(7) Using hand-held tester, shift to D position and hold
3rd gear by active test, and measure the line pressure in idling.
Specified line pressure:
(8)
Condition
D position
Idling
372 to 412 kPa
(3.8 to 4.2 kgf/cm2, 54 to 60 psi)
Turn the ignition switch off.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1192
DIAGNOSTICS
-
(9)
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1003
Disconnect the connector of the transmission wire.
HINT:
Disconnect the connector only when performing the D position
stall test.
(10) Start the engine.
(11) Firmly depress the brake pedal, shift to the D position, depress the accelerator pedal all the way down
and check the line pressure while the stall test is
performed.
Specified line pressure:
Transmission Wire
G30833
Condition
D position
Stall test
931 to 1,031 kPa
(9.5 to 10.5 kgf/cm2, 135 to 150 psi)
(12) Turn the ignition switch off.
(13) Remove the SST, install the test plug A.
(14) Remove the test plug B, install the SST and start engine.
SST 09992-00095 (09992- 00231, 09992-00271)
(15) Connect the transmission wire connector, depress
the brake pedal firmly, shift to the R position and
check that the line pressure while the engine is idling and during the stall test.
Specified line pressure:
Condition
R position
Idling
672 to 742 kPa
(6.9 to 7.6 kgf/cm2, 97 to 108 psi)
Stall test
1,768 to 1,968 kPa
(18.0 to 20.1 kgf/cm2, 256 to 285 psi)
(16) Remove the SST, install the test plug B.
(17) Clear the DTC.
Evaluation:
Problem
Possible cause
If the measured values at all position are higher
Shift solenoid valve (SLT) defective
Regulator valve defective
If the measured values at all position are lower
Shift solenoid valve (SLT) defective
Regulator valve defective
Oil pump defective
U/D (Underdrive) direct clutch defective
If pressure is low in the D position only
D position circuit fluid leak
Forward clutch defective
If pressure is low in the R position only
R position circuit fluid leak
Reverse clutch defective
1st and reverse brake defective
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1193
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1005
05EJZ-07
INITIALIZATION
1.
RESET MEMORY
CAUTION:
Perform the RESET MEMORY (AT initialization) when replacing the automatic transaxle assy, engine
assy or ECM.
NOTICE:
Hand-held tester only
HINT:
The ECM memorizes the condition that the ECT controls the automatic transaxle assy and engine assy according to those characteristics. Therefore, when the automatic transaxle assy, engine assy, or ECM has
been replaced, it is necessary to reset the memory so that the ECM can memorize the new information.
Reset procedure is as follows.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the hand-held tester main switch on.
(d) Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II”.
(e) Perform the reset memory procedure from the ENGINE menu.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1195
05-1006
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
CAUTION:
After performing the RESET MEMORY, be sure to perform the ROAD TEST (see page 05-997 ) described earlier.
HINT:
The ECM is learned by performing the ROAD TEST.
Tester menu flow:
G23367
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1196
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1007
05IRB-02
LIST OF DISABLE A MONITOR
HINT:
This table indicates ECM monitoring status for the items in the upper columns if the DTCs in each line on
the left are being set.
As for the ”X” mark, when the DTC on the left is stored, detection of the DTC in the upper column is not performed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1197
05-1008
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
A98648
A92385
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1198
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1009
A92386
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1199
05-1010
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
A98729
A92387
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1200
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-101 1
A92388
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1201
05-1012
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
A92389
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1202
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1013
A92390
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1203
05-1014
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05F2S-04
MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
1.
(a)
MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN FOR ECT TEST
Perform this drive pattern as one method to simulate the detection conditions of the ECT malfunctions.
(The DTCs may not be detected due the actual driving conditions. And some codes may not be detected through this drive pattern).
HINT:
Preparation for driving
Warm up the engine sufficiently. (Engine coolant temperature is 60 °C (140 °F) or higher)
Drive the vehicle when the atmospheric temperature is -10 °C (14 °F) or higher. (Malfunction is not
detected when the atmospheric temperature is -10 °C (14 °F) or less)
Driving note
Drive the vehicle through all gears.
Stop → 1st → 2nd → 3rd → 4th → 5th → 5th (lock-up ON).
Repeat the above driving pattern three times or more.
NOTICE:
The monitor status can be checked using the OBD II scan tool. When using the hand-held tester, monitor status can be found in the ”ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST” or under ”CARB OBD
II”.
In the event that the drive pattern must be interrupted (possibly due to traffic conditions or other
factors) the drive pattern can be resumed and, in most cases, the monitor can be completed.
CAUTION:
Perform this drive pattern on a level road as much as possible and strictly observe the posted speed
limits and traffic laws while driving.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1204
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1015
Vehicle Speed
Maintain a constant speed or gradual acceleration (with the throttle open)
for 3 minutes or more.*1
Lock-up ON
Vehicle Speed
Approx.100 km/h
(62 mph)
Approx. 80 km/h
(50 mph)
0
Warmed up
sufficiently
Stop
(Idling)
Normal acceleration
through all the gears from 1st to 5th
G31593
HINT:
*1: Drive at such a speed in the uppermost gear, to engage lock-up. The vehicle can be driven at a speed
lower than that in the above diagram under the lock-up condition.
NOTICE:
It is necessary to drive the vehicle for approximately 30 minutes to detect DTC P0711 (ATF temperature sensor malfunction).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1205
05-1000
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EJW-06
MECHANICAL SYSTEM TESTS
1.
(a)
PERFORM MECHANICAL SYSTEM TESTS
Measure the stall speed.
The object of this test is to check the overall performance of the transaxle and engine by measuring
the stall speeds in the D positions.
NOTICE:
Perform the test at the normal operating ATF (Automatic Transmission Fluid) temperature 50
to 80°C (122 to 176°F).
Do not continuously run this test for longer than 10 seconds.
To ensure safety, do this test in a wide, clear level area which provides good traction.
The stall test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe the conditions of wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while the other is doing the test.
(1) Chock the 4 wheels.
(2) Connect an OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(3) Fully apply the parking brake.
(4) Keep your left foot pressed firmly on the brake pedal.
(5) Start the engine.
(6) Shift into the D position. Press all the way down on the accelerator pedal with your right foot.
(7) Quickly read the stall speed at this time.
Stall speed:
U151E: 2,240 150 rpm
U151F: 2,550 150 rpm
Evaluation:
Problem
Possible cause
(a) Stall engine speed is low in D and R positions
Engine power output may be insufficient
Stator one-way clutch not operating properly
HINT: If the value is less than the specified value by 600 rpm or
more, the torque converter could be faulty.
(b) Stall engine speed is high in D position
Line pressure is too low
Forward clutch slipping
U/D (Underdrive) brake slipping
U/D (Underdrive) one-way clutch not operating properly
No.1 one-way clutch not operating properly
Line pressure is too low
Improper fluid level
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1190
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1001
(b)
Measure the time lag.
(1) When the shift lever is shifted while the engine is idling, there will be a certain time lapse or lag
before the shock can be felt. This is used for checking the condition of the direct clutch, forward
clutch, and 1st and reverse brake.
NOTICE:
Perform the test at the normal operating ATF temperature 50 to 80°C (122 to 176°F).
Be sure to allow 1 minute interval between tests.
Perform the test three times, and measure the time lags. Calculate the average value of the three
time lags.
(2) Connect an OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(3) Fully apply the parking brake.
(4) Start and warm up the engine and check idle speed.
Idle speed: approx. 700 rpm (In N position and A/C OFF)
(5) Shift the lever from N to D position. Using a stop watch, measure the time from when the lever
is shifted until the shock is felt.
Time lag: N → D less than 1.2 seconds
(6) In the same way, measure the time lag for N → R.
Time lag: N → R less than 1.5 seconds
Evaluation (If N → D or N → R time lag is longer than the specified):
Problem
Possible cause
N → D time lag is longer
Line pressure is too low
Forward clutch worn
No.1 one-way clutch not operating properly
U/D (Underdrive) one-way clutch not operating
U/D (Underdrive) brake worn
N → R time lag is longer
Line pressure is too low
Reverse clutch worn
1st and reverse brake worn
U/D (Underdrive) brake worn
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1191
05-1004
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EJY-07
MANUAL SHIFTING TEST
1.
PERFORM MANUAL SHIFTING TEST
HINT:
With this test, it can be determined whether the trouble occurs in the electrical circuit or is a mechanical problem in
the transaxle.
If any abnormalities are found in the following test, the
problem is in the transaxle itself.
(a) Disconnect the transmission wire connector.
(b) Drive with the transmission wire disconnected.
Shifting the shift lever to the L, 2, 3 and D position to check
whether the shifting condition changes the table below.
Transmission Wire
G30833
Shift Position
Shifting Condition
L⇔2
No Shift (Not Change)
2⇔3
Down Shift ⇔ Up Shift
3⇔D
No Shift (Not Change)
HINT:
When driving with the transmission wire disconnected, the gear
position will be as follows:
When the shift lever is in the L or the 2 position, the gear
is held in the 3rd position.
When the shift lever is in the D position, the gear is held
in the 4th position.
When the shift lever is in the R or the P position, the gear
is also in the R or the P position respectively.
(c) Connect the transmission wire connector.
(d) Clear the DTC (see page 05-1026 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1194
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-1 109
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05ITE-02
O/D MAIN SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The O/D main switch (transmission control switch) is a momentary type switch. When pressing the O/D main
switch, the O/D OFF indicator light lights up and the ECM prohibits shifting into O/D, and when pressing it
once again, the O/D OFF indicator light goes off and the ECM allows shifting into O/D. Turning the IG switch
OFF will reset the O/D OFF indicator light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center J/B
W-B
13
3F
T16
Transmission Control SW and
Transmission Shift Main SW
2
8
L
3H
IF3
W-B 6
2
ECM
GR
16
E5
ODMS
IB
G30835
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1299
05-1 110
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH-BODY
GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side:
(Connector Front View)
Disconnect the transmission control switch connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
T16
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
6 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
G23398
OK
2
INSPECT TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH
(a)
Switch Side:
(Connector Front View):
T16
G28380
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Press continuously transmission control switch
2-6
Below 1 Ω
Release transmission
control switch
↑
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH
(SEE PAGE 40-61 )
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH-ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
ODMS
G25190
Connect the transmission control switch connector.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Press continuously transmission control switch
E5 - 16 (ODMS) Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Release transmission
control switch
↑
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1016 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1300
05-1036
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0705
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EK9-08
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR CIRCUIT
MALFUNCTION (PRNDL INPUT)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch detects the shift lever position and sends signals to the ECM.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
(A) Any 2 or more signals of the following are ON simultaneously (2-trip detection logic)
P input signal is ON.
N input signal is ON.
R input signal is ON.
D input signal is ON.
3 input signal is ON.
2 input signal is ON.
(B) Any 2 or more signals of the following are ON simultaneously (2-trip detection logic)
NSW input signal is ON.
R input signal is ON.
D input signal is ON.
3 input signal is ON.
2 input signal is ON.
P0705
Open or short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch detects the shift lever position and sends a signal to the ECM.
For security, the park/neutral position switch detects the shift lever position so that engine can be started
only when the vehicle is in P or N shift position.
When the park/neutral position switch sends more than one signal at a time from switch positions P, R, N
or D, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the switch. The ECM will turn on the MIL and store the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0705: Park/neutral position switch/Verify switch input
Park/neutral position switch
Continuous
2 sec.
2 driving cycles
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Condition (A)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Ignition switch
ON
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Condition (B)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Ignition switch
ON
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1226
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1037
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
One of the following conditions is met: Condition (A) or (B)
Condition (A)
Number of the following signal input at the same time
2 or more
P switch
ON
R switch
ON
N switch
ON
D switch
ON
3 switch
ON
2 switch
ON
Condition (B)
Number of the following signal input at the same time
2 or more
NSW switch
ON
R switch
ON
D switch
ON
3 switch
ON
2 switch
ON
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Park/neutral Position switch
The park/neutral position switch sends only one signal to the ECM.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1227
05-1038
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
17
STA
E7
B
4
EB2
B
L-W
to STARTER Relay
P1
Park/Neutral Position SW
N 4
5 P
16
E7
B-R
T16 Transmission Control SW and
Transmission Shift Main SW
12
8
BR
R
IF3
IF3
5
1
G
7
IM1
Y-G
LL 8
9
2
E6
G
B
B
NSW
8
L
E6
R
J17
J/C
G
+B
G
18
IM1
P
20
3
E6
L-W
8
IM1
Y
10
D
E6
2L 3
DL 7
Passenger Side J/B
2 RB
R-B
20
IM1
L-Y
9
IM1
RL 1
R
PL 6
9
10
IM1
1
2
B
ALT
6
P
E5
J6
J/C
GR
C
7
1C
IG1
2
1G
R
11
R
E6
L
V
C
1
1A
1
G
6
1C
AM1
7
N
E5
GR
I15
Ignition SW
Instrument Panel J/B
F7
FL Block
W
5
4K
J6 J/C
B
B
19
IM1
Y-R
NL
6
4A
L
4
IG1
AM1 2
W
2
FL MAIN
Battery
G30834
G32477
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1228
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-1039
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Push the ”ON” button of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
(e) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST”.
(f)
According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Item
Measurement Item/
Range (display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
When the shift lever position displayed on the hand-held tester differs from the actual position, adjustment of the PNP switch or the
shift cable may be incorrect.
PNP SW [NSW]
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
P and N: ON
Except P and N: OFF
LOW
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
L: ON
Except L: OFF
↑
2ND
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
2 and L: ON
Except 2 and L: OFF
↑
REVERSE
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
R: ON
Except R: OFF
↑
DRIVE
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
D: ON
Except D: OFF
↑
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1229
05-1040
1
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY
(a)
(b)
Switch Side:
(Connector Front View):
Disconnect the park/neutral position switch connector.
Measure resistance according to the value(s) in the table
below when the shift lever is moved to each position.
Standard:
Shift Position
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P
2 - 6 and 4 - 5
Below 1 Ω
Except P
↑
10 kΩ or higher
R
2-1
Below 1 Ω
Except R
↑
10 kΩ or higher
N
2 - 9 and 4 - 5
Below 1 Ω
Except N
↑
10 kΩ or higher
D
2-7
Below 1 Ω
Except D
↑
10 kΩ or higher
3
2-3
Below 1 Ω
Except 3
↑
10 kΩ or higher
2 and L
2-8
Below 1 Ω
Except 2 and L
↑
10 kΩ or higher
P1
G26080
NG
REPLACE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-7 )
OK
2
INSPECT TRANSMISSION SHIFT MAIN SWITCH
(a)
(b)
Switch Side:
(Connector Front View):
(c)
T16
Connect the park/neutral position switch connector.
Disconnect the transmission control switch connector of
shift lever assy.
Measure resistance according to the value(s) in the table
below when the shift lever is moved to each position.
Standard:
Shift Position
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2
1-5
10 kΩ or higher
L
↑
Below 1 Ω
G28380
NG
REPLACE
TRANSMISSION
SWITCH (SEE PAGE 40-61 )
SHIFT
MAIN
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1230
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1041
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ECM)
E1(-)
NSW(+)
E7
E8
(a)
D(+) L(+) N(+)
2(+)
P(+)
R(+)
ON
E9
E6
(b)
Connect the transmission control switch connector of shift
lock control unit assy.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and measure
the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below
when the shift lever is moved to each position.
E5
3(+)
ECM:
G20666
Standard:
Shift Position
Tester connection
Specified condition
P and N
E7 - 16 (NSW) - Body ground
Below 1 V
Except P and N
↑
10 to 14 V
P
E5 - 6 (P) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Except P
↑
Below 1 V
N
E5 - 7 (N) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Except N
↑
Below 1 V
R
E6 - 11 (R) - Body ground
10 to 14 V*
Except R
↑
Below 1 V
D
E6 - 10 (D) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Except D
↑
Below 1 V
3
E6 - 20 (3) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Except 3
↑
Below 1 V
2 and L
E6 - 9 (2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Except 2 and L
↑
Below 1 V
L
E6 - 8 (L) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Except L
↑
Below 1 V
HINT:
*: The voltage will drop slightly due to lighting up of the back up
light.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1231
05-1042
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
DTC
P0710
TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE
SENSOR ”A” CIRCUIT
DTC
P0712
TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE
SENSOR ”A” CIRCUIT LOW INPUT
DTC
P0713
TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE
SENSOR ”A” CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
0527N-32
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ATF (Automatic Transmission Fluid) temperature sensor converts the fluid temperature into a resistance
value which is input into the ECM.
The ECM applies a voltage to the temperature sensor through ECM terminal THO1.
The sensor resistance changes with the transmission fluid temperature. As the temperature becomes higher, the sensor resistance decreases.
One terminal of the sensor is grounded so that the sensor resistance decreases and the voltage goes down
as the temperature becomes higher.
The ECM calculates the fluid temperature based on the voltage signal.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0710
(a) and (b) is detected momentary within 0.5 sec. when neither
P0712 or P0713 is not detected (1-trip detection logic)
(a) ATF temperature sensor resistance is less than 79 Ω.
(b) ATF temperature sensor resistance is more than 156 kΩ.
HINT:
Within 0.5 sec., the malfunction switches from (a) to (b) or from
(b) to (a)
Open or short in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
P0712
ATF temperature sensor resistance is less than 79 Ω for 0.5
sec. or more (1-trip detection logic)
Short in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
P0713
ATF temperature sensor resistance is more than 156 kΩ when
15 minutes or more after the engine start
DTC is detected for 0.5 sec. or more (1-trip detection logic)
Open in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The automatic transmission fluid (ATF) temperature sensor converts ATF temperature to an electrical resistance value. Based on the resistance, the ECM determines the ATF temperature, and the ECM detects an
opens or shorts in the ATF temperature circuit. If the resistance value of the ATF temperature is less than
79 Ω*1 or more than 156 kΩ*2, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the ATF sensor or wiring. The ECM will
turn on the MIL and store the DTC.
*1: 150C (302F) or more is indicated regardless of the actual ATF temperature.
*2: -40C (-40F) is indicated regardless of the actual ATF temperature.
HINT:
The ATF temperature can be checked on the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester display.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1232
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1043
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0710: ATF temperature sensor/Range check (Fluttering)
P0712: ATF temperature sensor/Range check (Low resistance)
P0713: ATF temperature sensor/Range check (High resistance)
ATF temperature sensor (TFT sensor)
Continuous
0.5 sec.
Immediate
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P0710: Range check (Fluttering)
P0712: Range check (Low resistance)
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present.
See page 05-1007
The typical enabling condition is not available.
-
P0713: Range check (High resistance)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Time after engine start
15 min. or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0710: Range check (Fluttering)
Less than 79 Ω
or
More than 156 kΩ
TFT (transmission fluid temperature) sensor
P0712: Range check (Low resistance)
Less than 79 Ω
TFT (transmission fluid temperature) sensor
P0713: Range check (High resistance)
TFT (transmission fluid temperature) sensor
More than 156 kΩ
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
TFT (transmission fluid temperature)
Atmospheric temperature - approx. 130C (266F)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1233
05-1044
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
E1
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
ECM
O
BR
E2
O
7
THO 1
Short Connector
5
5
S28
S29
BR
28
E7
E2
5V
32
E8
G-Y
THO1
G30836
G32447
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Push the ”ON” button of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
(f)
When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST”.
(g) According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Item
Measurement Item/
Range (display)
AT FLUID TEMP
ATF Temp. Sensor Value/
min.: -40C (-40F)
max.: 215C (419F)
Normal Condition
Approx. 80C (176F) (After Stall Test)
HINT:
When DTC P0712 is output and OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester output is 150C (302F), there is a
short circuit.
When DTC P0713 is output and OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester output is -40C (-40F), there is an
open circuit.
Measure the resistance between terminal THO1 (THO) and body ground.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-40 °C (-40°F)
Open circuit
150°C (302°F) or more
Short circuit
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1234
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
05-1045
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(ATF TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
(a)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
THO
(b)
E1
(c)
E2
G26426
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (THO) - 7 (E2)
79 Ω to 156 kΩ
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (THO) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
7 (E2) - Body ground
↑
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE
(SEE PAGE 40-37 )
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
THO1
ECM:
E2
(d)
G20668
Connect the transmission wire connector to the transaxle.
Disconnect the ECM connectors.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 32 (THO1) - E7 - 28 (E2)
79 Ω to 156 kΩ
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 32 (THO1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E7 - 28 (E2) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1235
05-1046
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0711
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05F2P-04
TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE
SENSOR ”A” PERFORMANCE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ATF (Automatic Transmission Fluid) temperature sensor converts the fluid temperature into a resistance
value which is input into the ECM.
DTC No.
P0711
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Both (a) and (b) are detected: (2-trip detection logic)
(a) Intake air and engine coolant temperatures are more than
-10°C (14F) at engine start
(b) After normal driving for over 19 min. and 9 km (6 mile) or
more, ATF temp. is less than 10°C (50F)
Open or short in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ATF temperature sensor converts the ATF temperature to an electrical resistance value. Based on the
resistance, the ECM determines the ATF temperature and detects an opens or shorts in the ATF temperature
circuit or a fault of the ATF temperature sensor.
After running the vehicle for a certain period, the ATF temperature should increase. If the ATF temperature
is below 10C (50F) after running the vehicle for a certain period, the ECM interprets this as a fault, and
turns on the MIL.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0711: ATF temperature sensor/Rationality check
ATF temperature sensor (TFT sensor)
Continuous
3 sec.
2 driving cycles
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
Time after engine start
See page 05-1007
16 min. and 40 sec. or more
ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
-15 C (5F) or more
TFT (transmission fluid temperature) sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
ECT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
IAT (Intake air temperature) sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Time after engine start
18 min. and 20 sec.
Driving distance after engine start
9 km (5.6 mile) or more
IAT (12 sec. after starting engine)
-10 C (14F) or more
ECT (12 sec. after starting engine)
-10 C (14F) or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TFT (transmission fluid temperature)
Less than 10C (50F)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
TFT (transmission fluid temperature)
Atmospheric temperature to approx. 130C (266F)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1236
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-1047
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
E1
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
ECM
O
BR
E2
O
7
THO 1
Short Connector
5
5
S28
S29
BR
28
E7
E2
5V
32
E8
G-Y
THO1
G30836
G32447
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Push the ”ON” button of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
(f)
When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST”.
(g) According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Item
Measurement Item/
Range (display)
AT FLUID TEMP
ATF Temp. Sensor Value/
min.: -40C (-40F)
max.: 215C (419F)
Normal Condition
Approx. 80C (176F) (After Stall Test)
HINT:
When DTC P0712 is output and OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester output is 150C (302F), there is a
short circuit.
When DTC P0713 is output and OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester output is -40C (-40F), there is an
open circuit.
Measure the resistance between terminal THO1 (THO) and body ground.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-40 °C (-40°F)
Open circuit
150°C (302°F) or more
Short circuit
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1237
05-1048
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
HINT:
If a circuit related to the ATF temperature sensor becomes open, P0713 is immediately set (in 0.5 second).
When P0713 is set, P0711 cannot be detected.
It is not necessary to inspect the circuit when P0711 is set.
1
CHECK OTHER DTCS OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0711)
(a)
(b)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch ON.
(c) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(d) Read the DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only ”P0711” is output
A
”P0711” and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides ”P0711” is output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1034 )
A
2
CHECK TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
OK:
Automatic transaxle fluid level is correct.
NG
ADD FLUID
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-37 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1238
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0717
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1049
05F2Q-04
TURBINE SPEED SENSOR CIRCUIT NO
SIGNAL
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the rotation speed of the input turbine. By comparing the input turbine speed signal (NT)
with the counter gear speed sensor signal (NC), the ECM detects the shift timing of the gears and appropriately controls the engine torque and hydraulic pressure according to various conditions. Thus, providing
smooth gear shift.
DTC No.
P0717
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
ECM detects conditions (a), (b) and (c) continuity for 5 sec. or
more: (1-trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 mph) or more
(b) Park/neutral position switch (NSW and R) is OFF
(c) Speed sensor (NT): less than 300 rpm
5 V/DIV
Open or short in transmission revolution sensor NT (speed
sensor NT) circuit
Transmission revolution sensor NT (speed sensor NT)
ECM
Automatic transaxle assembly
Reference (Using an oscilloscope):
Check the waveform between the terminals NT+ and NTof the ECM connector.
Standard: Refer to the illustration.
Terminal
NT+ - NT-
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 0.5ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph)
0.5 ms/DIV
C53419
C42920
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The NT terminal of the ECM detects a revolution signal from the speed sensor (NT) (input RPM). The ECM
calculates a gearshift comparing the speed sensor (NT) with the speed sensor (NC).
While the vehicle is operating in 2nd, 3rd, 4th or 5th gear in the shift position of D, if the input shaft revolution
is less than 300 rpm*1 although the output shaft revolution is more than 1,000 rpm*2, the ECM detects the
trouble, illuminates the MIL and stores the DTC.
*1: Pulse is not output or is irregularly output.
*2: The vehicle speed is 50 km/h (31 mph) or more.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0717: Speed sensor (NT)/Verify pulse input
Speed sensor (NT), Speed sensor (NC)
Continuous
5 sec.
Immediate
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1239
05-1050
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Shift change
Shift change is completed and before starting next shift change operation
ECM selected gear
2nd, 3rd, 4th or 5th
Output shaft rpm
1,000 rpm or more
NSW switch
OFF
R switch
OFF
L switch
OFF
Engine
Running
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Sensor signal rpm
Less than 300 rpm
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Speed sensor (NT)
Turbine speed is equal to engine speed when lock-up ON
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
T3
Turbine Speed Sensor
27
E8
W
1
2
NT+
5V
35
E8
R-W
NTE1
G31763
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
(a)
OK
Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
The installation bolt is tightened properly and there is
no clearance between the sensor and transaxle case.
NG
BR3795
NG
REPLACE SPEED SENSOR(NT)
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1240
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
05-1051
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR(NT)
(a)
Sensor Side:
(Connector Front View):
(b)
T3
2
Disconnect the speed sensor connector from the transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
1
C58536
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
1-2
560 to 680 Ω
REPLACE SPEED SENSOR(NT)
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SPEED SENSOR - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
Connect the speed sensor connector.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
NT+
NTECM:
C82158
C91565
(d)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
E8 - 27 (NT+) - E8 - 35 (NT-)
560 to 680 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 27 (NT+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E8 - 35 (NT-) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1241
05-1052
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0724
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EKC-05
BRAKE SWITCH ”B” CIRCUIT HIGH
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The purpose of this circuit is to prevent the engine from stalling while driving in lock-up condition, when
brakes are suddenly applied.
When the brake pedal is depressed, this switch sends a signals to the ECM. Then the ECM cancels the operation of the lock-up clutch while braking is in progress.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
The stop light switch remains ON even when the vehicle is
driven in a GO (30 km/h) and STOP (3 km/h) fashion 5 times.
(2-trip detection logic).
P0724
Short in stop light switch signal circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
This DTC indicates that the stop light switch remains on. When the stop light switch remains ON during ”stop
and go” driving, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the stop light switch and the MIL comes on and the ECM
stores the DTC. The vehicle must stop (less than 3 km/h (2 mph)) and go (30 km/h (19 mph) or more) 5 times
for two driving cycles in order to detect malfunction.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0724: Stop light switch/Rationality
Stop light switch, Vehicle speed sensor
Continuous
GO and STOP 5 times
2 driving cycles
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
GO (Vehicle speed is 30 km/h (18.63 mph) or more)
Once
STOP (Vehicle speed is less than 3 km/h (1.86 mph))
Once
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Brake switch
Remain ON during GO and STOP 5 times
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1242
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-1053
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
3
4L
B
1
2
ECM
Passenger Side J/B
S15
Stop Light SW
Y
12
4M
BR
19 STP
E6
Instrument Panel J/B
1
1E
STOP
1
1A
F7
FL Block
W
B
1
ALT
2
FL MAIN
Battery
G30837
G32448
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1243
05-1054
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Push the ”ON” button of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
(e) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST”.
(f)
According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
1
Item
Measurement Item/
Range (display)
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light SW Status/
ON or OFF
Normal Condition
Brake Pedal is depressed: ON
Brake Pedal is released: OFF
INSPECT STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
2
4
1
3
Free Pushed in
E65594
(a)
(b)
Remove the stop lamp switch assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Switch position
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Switch pin free
1-2
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
↑
Below 1 Ω
Switch pin free
3-4
Below 1 Ω
Switch pin pushed in
↑
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1244
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
05-1055
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY - ECM)
ECM:
E7
(a)
(b)
STP(+)
E8
E9
E6
E5
G26289
Install the stop lamp switch assy.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below when the brake pedal is depressed and released.
Standard:
Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Brake pedal is depressed
E6 - 19 (STP) Body ground
10 to 14 V
Brake pedal is released
↑
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1245
05-1056
DTC
DIAGNOSTICS
P0741
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EKD-05
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID
PERFORMANCE (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
DSL)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the signals from the throttle position sensor, Air-flow meter, turbine (input) speed sensor,
intermediate (counter) shaft speed sensor and crankshaft position sensor to monitor the engagement condition of the lock-up clutch.
Then the ECM compares the engagement condition of the lock-up clutch with the lock-up schedule in the
ECM memory to detect a mechanical problems of the shift solenoid valve DSL, valve body and torque converter clutch.
DTC No.
P0741
DTC Detection Condition
Lock-up does not occur when driving in lock-up range or lockup remains ON in lock-up OFF range (2-trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Shift solenoid valve DSL remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve DSL
Torque converter clutch
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
Line pressure is too low
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Torque converter lock-up is controlled by the ECM based on speed sensor (NT), speed sensor (NC), engine
rpm, engine load, engine temperature, vehicle speed, transmission temperature, and gear selection. The
ECM determines the lock-up status of the torque converter by comparing the engine rpm (NE) to the input
turbine rpm (NT). The ECM calculates the actual transmission gear by comparing input turbine rpm (NT) to
counter gear rpm (NC). When conditions are appropriate, the ECM requests ”lock-up” by applying control
voltage to shift solenoid DSL. When the DSL is turned on, solenoid DSL applies pressure to the lock-up relay
valve and locks the torque converter clutch.
If the ECM detects no lock-up after lock-up has been requested or if it detects lock-up when it is not requested, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the shift solenoid valve DSL or lock-up system performance.
The ECM will turn on the MIL and store the DTC.
Example:
When any of the following is met, the system judges it as a malfunction.
(a) There is a difference in rotation between before and after torque converters even when the ECM commands lock-up.
(Engine speed is at least 75 rpm greater than input turbine speed.)
(b) There is no difference in rotation between before and after torque converters even when the ECM commands lock-up off.
(The difference between engine speed and input turbine speed is less than 35 rpm.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1246
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1057
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
P0741: Shift solenoid valve DSL/OFF malfunction
P0741: Shift solenoid valve DSL/ON malfunction
Shift solenoid valve DSL, Speed sensor (NT), Speed sensor (NC),Crankshaft position sensor (NE), Throttle position sensor (VPA1), Mass air flow sensor (MAF),
Transmission temperature sensor (THO1), Engine coolant temperature sensor
(ECT)
Continuous
Duration
OFF malfunction
3.5 sec.
ON malfunction
1.8 sec.
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ALL:
Transmission range
”D”
ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
10C (50F) or more
TFT (Transmission fluid temperature)
-20 C (-4F) or more
TFT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
ECT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Turbine speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Intermediate shaft speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Output speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL3 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SR circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Not circuit malfunction
OFF malfunction
ECM lock-up command
ON
Duration time from lock-up on command
3 sec. or more
ECM selected gear
Vehicle speed
3rd, 4th or 5th
25 km/h (15.5 mph) or more
ON malfunction
ECM lock-up command
OFF
ECM selected gear
3rd, 4th or 5th
Throttle valve opening angle
Vehicle speed
10% or more
25 to 60 km/h (15.5 to 37.3 mph)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met: OFF malfunction or ON malfunction
OFF malfunction
Engine speed - Input (turbine) speed
100 rpm or more
ON malfunction
Diffierence between engine speed and input (turbine) speed
Less than 35 rpm
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1247
05-1058
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method
to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Push the ”ON” button of the hand-held tester.
(f)
When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/ACTIVE TEST”.
(g) According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
Item
LOCK UP
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
[Test Details]
Control the shift solenoid DSL to set the automatic transaxle to the
lock-up condition.
[Vehicle Condition]
Vehicle Speed: 60 km/h (37 mph) or more
Possible to check the DSL operation.
HINT:
(h)
HINT:
This test can be conducted when the vehicle speed is 60 km/h (37 mph) or more.
This test can be conducted with the 5th gear.
Lightly depress the accelerator pedal and check that the engine speed does not change abruptly.
When changing the accelerator pedal opening angle while driving, if the engine speed does not
change, lock-up is on.
Slowly release, but not fully, the accelerator pedal in order to decelerate. (Fully releasing the pedal will
close the throttle valve and lock-up may be turned off.)
Accelerator Pedal
Opening Angle
Accelerator Pedal
Fully Released
Lock-up OFF
Engine Speed
Lock-up ON
G23400
→ time
G29214
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1248
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1059
CHECK OTHER DTCS OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0741)
(a)
(b)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch ON.
(c) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(d) Read the DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only ”P0741” is output
A
”P0741” and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides ”P0741” is output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1034 )
A
2
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(DSL)
(a)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
(b)
E1
DSL
G26426
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
10 - Body ground
11 to 13 Ω
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
ECM:
C82158
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
DSL
C91565
Connect the transmission wire connector.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
E8 - 11 (DSL) - Body ground
11 to 13 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1249
05-1060
4
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(DSL)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve DSL:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
Solenoid Connector (DSL) - Solenoid
Body (DSL)
11 to 13 Ω
(c)
(-)
(+)
C90646
Remove the shift solenoid valve DSL.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Connect positive (+) lead to the terminal of solenoid connector, negative (-) lead to the solenoid body.
OK:
The solenoid valve makes an operating noise.
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(DSL)
OK
5
CHECK TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OK:
The connectors and pins are securely installed.
There is no open or short on the wire harness.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE
(SEE PAGE 40-37 )
OK
6
INSPECT TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY(See chapter 2 in the problem
symptoms table) (SEE PAGE 05-1016 )
OK:
There are no foreign objects on each valve and they operate smoothly.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION VALVE
BODY ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-44 )
OK
7
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-29 )
OK:
The torque converter clutch operates normally.
NG
REPLACE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
ASSY
OK
REPAIR AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-18 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1250
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0746
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1061
05C0Z-18
PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID ”A”
PERFORMANCE (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
SL1)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses signals from the vehicle speed sensor to detect the actual gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th
or 5th gear).
Then the ECM compares the actual gear with the shift schedule in the ECM memory to detect mechanical
problems of the shift solenoid valves and valve body.
DTC No.
P0746
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
The gear required by the ECM does not match the actual gear
when driving (2-trip detection logic)
Shift solenoid valve SL1 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve SL1
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. According to the input shaft
revolution, intermediate (counter) shaft revolution and output shaft revolution, the ECM detects the actual
gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th or 5th gear position). When the gear position commanded by the ECM and
the actual gear position are not same, the ECM illuminates the MIL.
Example:
When either condition (a) or (b) is met, the ECM detects a malfunction.
(a) The ECM commands the 1st gear, but the actual gear is 2nd.
(b) The ECM commands the 2nd gear, but the actual gear is 1st.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0746:
Shift solenoid valve SL1/OFF malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1/ON malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1, Speed sensor (NT), Speed sensor (NC), Crankshaft position sensor (NE)
Continuous
0.8 sec.
2 driving cycles
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1251
05-1062
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ALL:
Transmission range
”D”
ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
10C (50F) or more
TFT (Transmission fluid temperature)
-20 C (-4F) or more
TFT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
ECT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Turbine speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Intermediate shaft speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Output speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL3 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SR circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Not circuit malfunction
OFF malfunction
ECM selected gear
Vehicle speed
Throttle valve opening angle
1st
Less than 40 km/h (24.9 mph)
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
ON malfunction
ECM selected gear
Throttle valve opening angle
2nd
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met: OFF malfunction or ON malfunction
OFF malfunction
2 detections are necessary per driving cycle:
1st detection; temporary flag ON
2nd detection; pending fault code ON
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
1.49 to 1.63
ON malfunction
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
2.72 to 2.86
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1252
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1063
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method
to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Push the ”ON” button of the hand-held tester.
(e) Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/ACTIVE TEST/SHIFT”.
(f)
According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
HINT:
While driving, the shift position can be forcibly changed with the hand-held tester.
Comparing the shift position commanded by the ACTIVE TEST with the actual shift position enables you
to confirm the problem (see page 05-1030 ).
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SHIFT
[Test Details]
Operate the shift solenoid valve and set the each shift position by yourself.
[Vehicle Condition]
Less than 50 km/h (31 mph)
[Others]
Press ”→” button: Shift up
Press ”←” button: Shift down
Possible to check the operation of
the shift solenoid valves.
HINT:
This test can be conducted when the vehicle speed is 50 km/h (31 mph) or less.
The shift position commanded by the ECM is shown in the DATA LIST/SHIFT display on the hand-held
tester.
1
CHECK OTHER DTCS OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0746)
(a)
(b)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch ON.
(c) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(d) Read the DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only ”P0746” is output
A
”P0746” and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides ”P0746” is output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1034 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1253
05-1064
2
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL1)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve SL1:
1
2
(c)
2
1
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve SL1.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
1-2
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Connect the positive (+) lead with a 21 W bulb to terminal
2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solenoid
valve connector, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
(+)
G20767
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL1)
OK
3
INSPECT TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY(See chapter 2 in the problem
symptoms table) (SEE PAGE 05-1016 )
OK:
There are no foreign objects on each valve and they operate smoothly.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION VALVE
BODY ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-44 )
OK
4
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-29 )
OK:
The torque converter clutch operates normally.
NG
REPLACE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-18 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1254
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0748
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1065
05C10-20
PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID ”A”
ELECTRICAL (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
SL1)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Shifting from 1st to 5th is performed in combination with ”ON” and ”OFF” operation of the shift solenoid valves
SL1, SL2, SL3, S4 and SR which is controlled by the ECM. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the
shift solenoid valves, the ECM controls the remaining normal shift solenoid valve to allow the vehicle to be
operated smoothly (Fail safe function).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0748
ECM checks for an open or short circuit in shift solenoid valves
SL1 (1-trip detection logic)
Output signal duty equals to 100%
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL1
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. When there is an open or
short circuit in any shift solenoid valve circuit, the ECM detects the problem and illuminates the MIL and
stores the DTC. And the ECM performs the fail-safe function and turns the other shift solenoid valves in good
condition ”ON/OFF” (In case of an open or short circuit, the ECM stops sending current to the circuit.)
(see page 05-1030 ).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0748: Shift solenoid valve SL1/Range check
Shift solenoid valve SL1
Continuous
1 sec.
Immediate
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Battery voltage
10 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Output signal duty
100%
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Output signal duty
Less than 100%
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1255
05-1066
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
E1 Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
W
19
E8
R-B
6
SL1+
CPU
SL1+
B
18 SL1E8
B-W
13
SL1-
ECM
+B
G31765
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(SL1)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
SL1+
SL1-
(a)
E1
(b)
G26426
(c)
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
6 (SL1+) - 13 (SL1-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
SL1+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
SL1- - Body ground
↑
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1256
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
05-1067
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
Connect the transmission connector to the transaxle.
Disconnect the connector from the ECM.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
E8 - 19 (SL1+) - E8 - 18 (SL1-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
ECM:
SL1+
SL1C82158
C91565
(d)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 19 (SL1+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E8 - 18 (SL1-) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
3
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL1)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve SL1:
1
2
(c)
2
1
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve SL1.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
1-2
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Connect the positive (+) lead with a 21 W bulb to terminal
2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solenoid
valve connector, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
(+)
G20767
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL1)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-37 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1257
05-1068
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0766
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05C11-20
SHIFT SOLENOID ”D” PERFORMANCE
(SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE S4)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses signals from the vehicle speed sensor to detect the actual gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th
or 5th gear).
Then the ECM compares the actual gear with the shift schedule in the ECM memory to detect mechanical
problems of the shift solenoid valves and valve body.
DTC No.
P0766
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
The gear required by the ECM does not match the actual gear
when driving (2-trip detection logic)
Shift solenoid valve S4 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve S4
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. According to the input shaft
revolution, intermediate (counter) shaft revolution and output shaft revolution, the ECM detects the actual
gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th or 5th gear position). When the gear position commanded by the ECM and
the actual gear position are not same, the ECM illuminates the MIL and stores the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0766:
Shift solenoid valve S4/ON malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4/OFF malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4, Speed sensor (NT), Speed sensor (NC), Crankshaft position sensor (NE)
Continuous
OFF malfunction (A) and ON malfunction (B)
1 sec.
OFF malfunction (B)
1.2 sec.
ON malfunction (A)
0.8 sec.
2 driving cycles
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1258
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1069
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Transmission range
”D”
ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
10C (50F) or more
TFT (Transmission fluid temperature)
-20 C (-4F) or more
TFT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
ECT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Turbine speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Intermediate shaft speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Output speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL3 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SR circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Not circuit malfunction
OFF malfunction (A)
ECM selected gear
5th
Throttle valve opening angle
5% or more
Vehicle speed
10 km/h (6.2 mph) or more
OFF malfunction (B)
ECM lock-up command
ON
ECM selected gear
3rd, 4th or 5th
Throttle valve opening angle
10% or more
Vehicle speed
25 to 100 km/h (15.5 to 62.1 mph)
ON malfunction (A)
ECM selected gear
Throttle valve opening angle
4th or 5th
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
ON malfunction (B)
ECM selected gear
4th
Throttle valve opening angle
5% or more
Vehicle speed
10 km/h (6.2 mph) or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met:
OFF malfunction (A) and (B), or ON malfunction (A) and (B)
2 detections are necessary per driving cycle:
1st detection; temporary flag ON
2nd detection; pending fault code ON
OFF malfunction (A)
Intermediate shaft speed/Output speed
1.44 to 1.58
OFF malfunction (B)
Difference between engine speed and input (turbine) speed
Less than 35 rpm
ON malfunction (A)
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
0.64 to 0.74
ON malfunction (B)
Intermediate shaft speed/Output speed
1.02 to 1.16
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1259
05-1070
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method
to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Push the ”ON” button of the hand-held tester.
(e) Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/ACTIVE TEST/SHIFT”.
(f)
According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
HINT:
While driving, the shift position can be forcibly changed with the hand-held tester.
Comparing the shift position commanded by the ACTIVE TEST with the actual shift position enables you
to confirm the problem (see page 05-1030 ).
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SHIFT
[Test Details]
Operate the shift solenoid valve and set the each shift position by yourself.
[Vehicle Condition]
Less than 50 km/h (31 mph)
[Others]
Press ”→” button: Shift up
Press ”←” button: Shift down
Possible to check the operation of
the shift solenoid valves.
HINT:
This test can be conducted when the vehicle speed is 50 km/h (31 mph) or less.
The shift position commanded by the ECM is shown in the DATA LIST/SHIFT display on the hand-held
tester.
1
CHECK OTHER DTCS OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0766)
(a)
(b)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch ON.
(c) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(d) Read the DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only ”P0766” is output
A
”P0766” and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides ”P0766” is output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1034 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1260
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1071
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(S4)
(-)
Shift Solenoid Valve S4:
(a)
(b)
(+)
C90639
Remove the shift solenoid valve S4.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
Solenoid Connector (S4) - Solenoid
Body (S4)
11 to 15 Ω
(c)
Connect positive (+) lead to the terminal of solenoid connector, negative (-) lead to the solenoid body.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(S4)
OK
3
INSPECT TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY(See chapter 2 in the problem
symptoms table) (SEE PAGE 05-1016 )
OK:
There are no foreign objects on each valve and they operate smoothly.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION VALVE
BODY ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-44 )
OK
4
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-29 )
OK:
The torque converter clutch operates normally.
NG
REPLACE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-18 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1261
05-1072
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0771
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05C12-12
SHIFT SOLENOID ”E” PERFORMANCE
(SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE SR)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses signals from the vehicle speed sensor to detect the actual gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th
or 5th gear).
Then the ECM compares the actual gear with the shift schedule in the ECM memory to detect mechanical
problems of the shift solenoid valves and valve body.
DTC No.
P0771
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
The gear required by the ECM does not match the actual gear
when driving (2-trip detection logic)
Shift solenoid valve SR remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve SR
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. According to the input shaft
revolution, intermediate (counter) shaft revolution and output shaft revolution, the ECM detects the actual
gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th or 5th gear position). When the gear position commanded by the ECM and
the actual gear position are not same, the ECM illuminates the MIL and stores the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0771: Shift solenoid valve SR/Rationality check
Shift solenoid valve SR, Speed sensor (NT), Speed sensor (NC), Crankshaft position sensor (NE)
Continuous
OFF malfunction (A)
1 sec.
OFF malfunction (B)
3.5 sec.
ON malfunction (A)
Continuous
ON malfunction (B) and (C)
0.8 sec.
2 driving cycles
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1262
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1073
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Transmission range
”D”
ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
10C (50F) or more
TFT (Transmission fluid temperature)
-20 C (-4F) or more
TFT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
ECT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Turbine speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Intermediate shaft speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Output speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL3 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SR circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Not circuit malfunction
OFF malfunction (A)
ECM selected gear
5th
Throttle valve opening angle
Vehicle speed
5% or more
10 km/h (6.2 mph) or more
OFF malfunction (B)
ECM lock-up command
ON
ECM selected gear
Vehicle speed
3rd, 4th or 5th
25 km/h (15.5 mph)
ON malfunction (A)
ECM lock-up command
OFF
ON malfunction (B)
ECM selected gear
Vehicle speed
Throttle valve opening angle
1st
Less than 40 km/h (24.9 mph)
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
ON malfunction (C)
ECM selected gear
Throttle valve opening angle
3rd
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
ON malfunction (D)
ECM selected gear
4th or 5th
Duration time from shift command of ECM
15 sec. or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1263
05-1074
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met:
OFF malfunction (A) and (B), or ON malfunction (A), (B), (C) and (D)
OFF malfunction (A)
Intermediate shaft speed/Output speed
1.44 to 1.58
OFF malfunction (B)
Engine speed - Input (turbine) speed
When condition ”OFF malfunction (A)” of shift solenoid ”D”
is detected;
When condition ”OFF malfunction (A)” of shift solenoid ”D”
is not detected;
75 rpm or more
100 rpm or more
ON malfunction (A)
Difference between engine speed and input (turbine) speed
150 rpm or more
ON malfunction (B)
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
0.93 to 1.07
ON malfunction (C)
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
0.93 to 1.07
ON malfunction (D)
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
0.64 to 0.74
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1264
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1075
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method
to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Push the ”ON” button of the hand-held tester.
(e) Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/ACTIVE TEST/SHIFT”.
(f)
According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
HINT:
While driving, the shift position can be forcibly changed with the hand-held tester.
Comparing the shift position commanded by the ACTIVE TEST with the actual shift position enables you
to confirm the problem (see page 05-1030 ).
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SHIFT
[Test Details]
Operate the shift solenoid valve and set the each shift position by yourself.
[Vehicle Condition]
Less than 50 km/h (31 mph)
[Others]
Press ”→” button: Shift up
Press ”←” button: Shift down
Possible to check the operation of
the shift solenoid valves.
HINT:
This test can be conducted when the vehicle speed is 50 km/h (31 mph) or less.
The shift position commanded by the ECM is shown in the DATA LIST/SHIFT display on the hand-held
tester.
1
CHECK OTHER DTCS OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0771)
(a)
(b)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch ON.
(c) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(d) Read the DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only ”P0771” is output
A
”P0771” and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides ”P0771” is output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1034 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1265
05-1076
2
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SR)
(+)
Shift Solenoid Valve SR:
(a)
(b)
(-)
C90640
Remove the shift solenoid valve SR.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
Solenoid Connector (SR) - Solenoid
Body (SR)
11 to 15 Ω
(c)
Connect positive (+) lead to the terminal of solenoid connector, negative (-) lead to the solenoid body.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SR)
OK
3
INSPECT TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY(See chapter 2 in the problem
symptoms table) (SEE PAGE 05-1016 )
OK:
There are no foreign objects on each valve and they operate smoothly.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION VALVE
BODY ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-44 )
OK
4
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-29 )
OK:
The torque converter clutch operates normally.
NG
REPLACE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-18 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1266
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0776
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1077
05C13-18
PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID ”B”
PERFORMANCE (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
SL2)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses signals from the vehicle speed sensor to detect the actual gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th
or 5th gear).
Then the ECM compares the actual gear with the shift schedule in the ECM memory to detect mechanical
problems of the shift solenoid valves and valve body.
DTC No.
P0776
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
The gear required by the ECM does not match the actual gear
when driving (2-trip detection logic)
Shift solenoid valve SL2 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve SL2
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. According to the input shaft
revolution, intermediate (counter) shaft revolution and output shaft revolution, the ECM detects the actual
gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th or 5th gear position). When the gear position commanded by the ECM and
the actual gear position are not same, the ECM illuminates the MIL and stores the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0776:
Shift solenoid valve SL2/OFF malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2/ON malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2, Speed sensor (NT), Speed sensor (NC), Crankshaft position sensor (NE)
Continuous
OFF malfunction (A)
1.8 sec.
OFF malfunction (B) and (C)
0.8 sec.
ON malfunction (A) and (B)
0.8 sec.
ON malfunction (C)
0.4 sec.
2 driving cycles
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1267
05-1078
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Transmission range
”D”
ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
10C (50F) or more
TFT (Transmission fluid temperature)
-20 C (-4F) or more
TFT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
ECT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Turbine speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Intermediate shaft speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Output speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL3 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SR circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Not circuit malfunction
OFF malfunction (A)
ECM lock-up command
Vehicle speed
OFF
Less than 60 km/h (37.3 mph)
Throttle valve opening angle
10% or more
OFF malfunction (B)
ECM selected gear
Vehicle speed
Throttle valve opening angle
1st
Less than 40 km/h (24.9 mph)
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
OFF malfunction (C)
ECM selected gear
Throttle valve opening angle
3rd
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
OFF malfunction (D)
ECM select gear
4th or 5th
Duration time from shift command of ECM
15 sec. or more
ON malfunction (A)
ECM select gear
Vehicle speed
Throttle valve opening angle
1st
Less than 40 km/h (24.9 mph)
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
ON malfunction (B)
ECM selected gear
Throttle valve opening angle
3rd
7.0% or more at output speed 1,400 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
Malfunction of pressure control solenoid ”B” (SL2) and ”C”
(SL3)
Not detected
ON malfunction (C)
Throttle valve opening angle
7.0% or more at output speed 1,050 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
Malfunction of pressure control solenoid ”B” (SL2)
Not detected
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1268
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1079
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met:
OFF malfunction (A), (B), (C) and (D), or ON malfunction (A), (B) and (C)
OFF malfunction (A)
Difference between engine speed and input (turbine) speed
Less than 35 rpm
OFF malfunction (B)
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
0.93 to 1.07
OFF malfunction (C)
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
0.93 to 1.07
OFF malfunction (D)
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
0.64 to 0.74
ON malfunction (A)
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
2.72 to 2.86
ON malfunction (B)
Input (turbine) speed - Intermediate shaft speed
700 rpm or more
ON malfunction (C)
Input (turbine) speed - Intermediate shaft speed
Less than -500 rpm
or
700 rpm or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1269
05-1080
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method
to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Push the ”ON” button of the hand-held tester.
(e) Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/ACTIVE TEST/SHIFT”.
(f)
According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
HINT:
While driving, the shift position can be forcibly changed with the hand-held tester.
Comparing the shift position commanded by the ACTIVE TEST with the actual shift position enables you
to confirm the problem (see page 05-1030 ).
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SHIFT
[Test Details]
Operate the shift solenoid valve and set the each shift position by yourself.
[Vehicle Condition]
Less than 50 km/h (31 mph)
[Others]
Press ”→” button: Shift up
Press ”←” button: Shift down
Possible to check the operation of
the shift solenoid valves.
HINT:
This test can be conducted when the vehicle speed is 50 km/h (31 mph) or less.
The shift position commanded by the ECM is shown in the DATA LIST/SHIFT display on the hand-held
tester.
1
CHECK OTHER DTCS OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0776)
(a)
(b)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch ON.
(c) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(d) Read the DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only ”P0776” is output
A
”P0776” and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides ”P0776” is output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1034 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1270
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1081
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL2)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve SL2:
1
2
(c)
2
1
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve SL2.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
1-2
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Connect the positive (+) lead with a 21 W bulb to terminal
2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solenoid
valve connector, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
(+)
G20767
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL2)
OK
3
INSPECT TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY(See chapter 2 in the problem
symptoms table) (SEE PAGE 05-1016 )
OK:
There are no foreign objects on each valve and they operate smoothly.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION VALVE
BODY ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-44 )
OK
4
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-29 )
OK:
The torque converter clutch operates normally.
NG
REPLACE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-18 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1271
05-1082
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0778
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05C14-18
PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID ”B”
ELECTRICAL (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
SL2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Shifting from 1st to 5th is performed in combination with ”ON” and ”OFF” operation of the shift solenoid valves
SL1, SL2, SL3, S4 and SR which is controlled by the ECM. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the
shift solenoid valves, the ECM controls the remaining normal shift solenoid valve to allow the vehicle to be
operated smoothly (Fail safe function).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0778
ECM checks for an open or short circuit in shift solenoid valves
SL2 (1-trip detection logic)
Hybrid IC for solenoid indicates fail.
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL2
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. When there is an open or
short circuit in any shift solenoid valve circuit, the ECM detects the problem and illuminates the MIL and
stores the DTC. And the ECM performs the fail-safe function and turns the other shift solenoid valves in good
condition ”ON/OFF” (In case of an open or short circuit, the ECM stops sending current to the circuit.)
(see page 05-1030 ).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0778: Shift solenoid valve SL2/Range check
Shift solenoid valve SL2
Continuous
1 sec.
Immediate
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Solenoid current cut status
Not cut
Battery voltage
11 V or more
CPU commanded duty ratio to SL2
19% or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Solenoid status from IC
Fail (Open or short)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Output signal duty
Less than 100%
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1272
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-1083
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
E1 Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
LG
15
E8
L-Y
SL2+ 5
CPU
SL2+
BR
14
E8
L-R
SL2-
ECM
+B
SL2-
12
G31765
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(SL2)
(a)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
SL2+
(b)
E1
SL2-
G26426
(c)
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
5 (SL2+) - 12 (SL2-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
OK:
Standard (Check for short):
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
5 (SL2+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
12 (SL2-) - Body ground
↑
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1273
05-1084
2
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
SL2+
C82158
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
ECM:
SL2-
C91565
(d)
Connect the transmission connector to the transaxle.
Disconnect the connector from the ECM.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
E8 - 15 (SL2+) - E8 - 14 (SL2-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 15 (SL2+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E8 - 14 (SL2-) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
3
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL2)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve SL2:
1
2
(c)
2
1
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve SL2.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
1-2
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Connect the positive (+) lead with a 21 W bulb to terminal
2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solenoid
valve connector, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
(+)
G20767
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL2)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-37 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1274
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0793
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1085
05F2R-04
INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SPEED SENSOR
”A”
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the rotation speed of the counter gear. By comparing the counter gear speed signal (NC)
with the direct clutch speed sensor signal (NT), the ECM detects the shift timing of the gears and appropriately controls the engine torque and hydraulic pressure according to various conditions. Thus smooth gear shifting is performed.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
ECM detects conditions (a), (b) and (c) continuity for 5 sec. or
more: (1-trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 mph) or more
(b) Park/neutral position switch (NSW) is OFF
(c) Speed sensor (NC): less than 300 rpm
P0793
1 V/DIV
Open or short in transmission revolution sensor NC (speed
sensor NC) circuit
Transmission revolution sensor NC (speed sensor NC)
ECM
Reference (Using an oscilloscope):
Check the waveform between the terminals NC+ and
NC- of the ECM connector.
Standard: Refer to the illustration.
Terminal
NC+ - NC-
Tool setting
1V/DIV, 1ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Vehicle speed 30 km/h (19 mph): (3rd gear)
Engine speed 1,400 rpm
1 ms/DIV
C93866
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The NC terminal of ECM detects a revolution signal from the speed sensor (NC) (counter gear rpm). The
ECM calculates a gearshift comparing the speed sensor (NT) with the speed sensor (NC).
While the vehicle is operating in 2nd, 3rd, 4th or 5th gear in the shift position of D, if the counter gear revolution is less than 300 rpm*1 although the output shaft revolution is more than 1,000 rpm*2, the ECM detects
the trouble, illuminates the MIL and stores the DTC.
*1: Pulse is not output or is irregularly output.
*2: The vehicle speed is 50 km/h (31 mph) or more.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0793: Speed sensor (NC)/Verify pulse input
Speed sensor (NC), Speed sensor (NT), Park/neutral position switch
Continuous
5 sec.
Immediate
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Engine
Running
NSW switch
OFF
Output shaft rpm
1,000 rpm or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1275
05-1086
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Sensor signal rpm
Less than 300 rpm
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
[HINT]
3rd when shift lever position is D position (After warming up the engine);
Intermediate shaft speed (NC) becomes close to the engine speed.
Counter gear speed sensor (NC)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
C6
Counter Gear Speed Sensor
26
R
1
NC+
E8
2
5V
34
E8
W-G
NCE1
G31763
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1276
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1087
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Push the ”ON” button of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
(f)
When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST”.
(g) According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Measurement Item/
Range (display)
Item
Normal Condition
[HINT]
3rd when shift lever position is D position (After
warming up the engine);
Intermediate shaft speed (NC) becomes close
to the engine speed.
Counter Gear Speed/
display: 50 r/min
SPD (NC)
HINT:
SPD (NC) is always 0 while driving:
Open or short in the sensor or circuit.
SPD (NC) is always more than 0 and less than 300 rpm while driving the vehicle at 50 km/h (31 mph)
or more:
Sensor trouble, improper installation, or intermittent connection trouble of the circuit.
1
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
(a)
OK
Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
The installation bolt is tightened properly and there is
no clearance between the sensor and transaxle case.
NG
BR3795
NG
REPLACE SPEED SENSOR(NC)
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1277
05-1088
2
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR(NC)
(a)
Sensor Side:
(Connector Front View):
(b)
C6
2
Disconnect the speed sensor connector from the transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
1
C58536
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
1-2
560 to 680 Ω
REPLACE SPEED SENSOR(NC)
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SPEED SENSOR - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
Connect the speed sensor connector.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
NC+
NCC82158
ECM:
C91565
(d)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
E8 - 26 (NC+) - E8 - 34 (NC-)
560 to 680 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 26 (NC+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E8 - 34 (NC-) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1278
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0796
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1089
05C15-12
PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID ”C”
PERFORMANCE (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
SL3)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses signals from the vehicle speed sensor to detect the actual gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th
or 5th gear).
Then the ECM compares the actual gear with the shift schedule in the ECM memory to detect mechanical
troubles of the shift solenoid valves and valve body.
DTC No.
P0796
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
The gear required by the ECM does not match the actual gear
when driving (2-trip detection logic)
Shift solenoid valve SL3 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve SL3
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. According to the input shaft
revolution, intermediate (counter) shaft revolution and output shaft revolution, the ECM detects the actual
gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th or 5th gear position). When the gear position commanded by the ECM and
the actual gear position are not same, the ECM illuminates the MIL and stores the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0796:
Shift solenoid valve SL3/OFF malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL3/ON malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL3, Speed sensor (NT), Speed sensor (NC), Crankshaft position sensor (NE)
Continuous
OFF malfunction (A)
0.8 sec.
OFF malfunction (B)
1 sec.
ON malfunction (A) and (B)
0.8 sec.
ON malfunction (C)
0.4 sec.
2 driving cycles
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1279
05-1090
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Transmission range
”D”
ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
10C (50F) or more
TFT (Transmission fluid temperature)
-20 C (-4F) or more
TFT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
ECT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Turbine speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Intermediate shaft speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Output speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL3 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SR circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Not circuit malfunction
OFF malfunction (A)
ECM selected gear
Throttle valve opening angle
4th or 5th
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
OFF malfunction (B)
ECM selected gear
4th
Throttle valve opening angle
Vehicle speed
5% or more
10 km/h (6.2 mph) or more
ON malfunction (A)
ECM selected gear
Vehicle speed
Throttle valve opening angle
1st
Less than 40 km/h (24.9 mph)
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
ON malfunction (B)
ECM selected gear
Throttle valve opening angle
3rd
7.0% or more at output speed 1,400 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
Malfunction of pressure control solenoid ”B” (SL2) and ”C”
(SL3)
Not detected
ON malfunction (C)
Throttle valve opening angle
7.0% or more at output speed 1,050 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
Malfunction of pressure control solenoid ”B” (SL2)
Not detected
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1280
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1091
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met:
OFF malfunction (A) and (B), or ON malfunctions (A), (B) and (C)
2 detections are necessary per driving cycle:
1st detection; temporary flag ON
2nd detection; pending fault code ON
OFF malfunction (A)
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
0.93 to 1.07
OFF malfunction (B)
Intermediate shaft speed/Output speed
1.02 to 1.16
ON malfunction (A)
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
0.93 to 1.07
ON malfunction (B)
Input (turbine) speed - Intermediate shaft speed
700 rpm or more
ON malfunction (C)
Input (turbine) speed - Intermediate shaft speed
Less than -500 rpm
or
700 rpm or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1281
05-1092
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method
to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Push the ”ON” button of the hand-held tester.
(e) Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/ACTIVE TEST/SHIFT”.
(f)
According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
HINT:
While driving, the shift position can be forcibly changed with the hand-held tester.
Comparing the shift position commanded by the ACTIVE TEST with the actual shift position enables you
to confirm the problem (see page 05-1030 ).
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SHIFT
[Test Details]
Operate the shift solenoid valve and set the each shift position by yourself.
[Vehicle Condition]
Less than 50 km/h (31 mph)
[Others]
Press ”→” button: Shift up
Press ”←” button: Shift down
Possible to check the operation of
the shift solenoid valves.
HINT:
This test can be conducted when the vehicle speed is 50 km/h (31 mph) or less.
The shift position commanded by the ECM is shown in the DATA LIST/SHIFT display on the hand-held
tester.
1
CHECK OTHER DTCS OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0796)
(a)
(b)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch ON.
(c) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(d) Read the DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only ”P0796” is output
A
”P0796” and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides ”P0796” is output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-1034 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1282
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1093
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL3)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve SL3:
1
2
(c)
2
1
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve SL3.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
1-2
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Connect the positive (+) lead with a 21 W bulb to terminal
2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solenoid
valve connector, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
(+)
G20767
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL3)
OK
3
INSPECT TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY(See chapter 2 in the problem
symptoms table) (SEE PAGE 05-1016 )
OK:
There are no foreign objects on each valve and they operate smoothly.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION VALVE
BODY ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-44 )
OK
4
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-29 )
OK:
The torque converter clutch operates normally.
NG
REPLACE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-18 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1283
05-1094
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0798
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05C16-22
PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID ”C”
ELECTRICAL (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
SL3)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Shifting from 1st to 5th is performed in combination with ”ON” and ”OFF” operation of the shift solenoid valves
SL1, SL2, SL3, S4 and SR which is controlled by the ECM. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the
shift solenoid valves, the ECM controls the remaining normal shift solenoid valve to allow the vehicle to be
operated smoothly (Fail safe function).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0798
ECM checks for an open or short circuit in shift solenoid valves
SL3 (1-trip detection logic)
Output signal duty equals to 100%
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL3 circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL3
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. When there is an open or
short circuit in any shift solenoid valve circuit, the ECM detects the problem and illuminates the MIL and
stores the DTC. And the ECM performs the fail-safe function and turns the other shift solenoid valves in good
condition ”ON/OFF” (In case of an open or short circuit, the ECM stops sending current to the circuit.)
(see page 05-1030 ).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0798: Shift solenoid valve SL3/Range check
Shift solenoid valve SL3
Continuous
1 sec.
Immediate
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Battery voltage
10 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Output signal duty
100%
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Output signal duty
Less than 100%
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1284
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-1095
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
E1 Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
R
17
E8
G-B
SL3+
4
CPU
SL3+
L
16
E8
G-R
11
SL3-
ECM
+B
SL3-
G31765
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(SL3)
(a)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
SL3+
E1
SL3-
(b)
G26426
(c)
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
4 (SL3+) - 11 (SL3-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
4 (SL3+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
11 (SL3-) - Body ground
↑
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1285
05-1096
2
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
ECM:
SL3+
C82158
SL3-
C91565
(d)
Connect the transmission connector to the transaxle.
Disconnect the connector from the ECM.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
E8 - 17 (SL3+) - E8 - 16 (SL3-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 17 (SL3+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E8 - 16 (SL3-) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
3
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL3)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve SL3:
1
2
(c)
2
1
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve SL3.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
1-2
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Connect the positive (+) lead with a 21 W bulb to terminal
2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solenoid
valve connector, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
(+)
G20767
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL3)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-37 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1286
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1097
05C17-24
DTC
P0982
SHIFT SOLENOID ”D” CONTROL CIRCUIT
LOW (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE S4)
DTC
P0983
SHIFT SOLENOID ”D” CONTROL CIRCUIT
HIGH (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE S4)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Shifting from 1st to 5th is performed in combination with ”ON” and ”OFF” operation of the shift solenoid valves
SL1, SL2, SL3, S4 and SR which is controlled by the ECM. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the
shift solenoid valves, the ECM controls the remaining normal shift solenoid valve to allow the vehicle to be
operated smoothly (Fail safe function).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0982
ECM detects short in solenoid valve S4 circuit 2 times when
solenoid valve S4 is operated (1-trip detection logic)
Short in shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Shift solenoid valve S4
ECM
P0983
ECM detects open in solenoid valve S4 circuit 2 times when
solenoid valve S4 is not operated (1-trip detection logic)
Open in shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Shift solenoid valve S4
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. When there is an open or
short circuit in any shift solenoid valve circuit, the ECM detects the problem and illuminates the MIL and
stores the DTC. And the ECM performs the fail-safe function and turns the other shift solenoid valves in good
condition ”ON/OFF” (In case of an open or short circuit, the ECM stops sending current to the circuit.)
(see page 05-1030 ).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
P0982: Shift solenoid valve S4/Range check (Low resistance)
P0983: Shift solenoid valve S4/Range check (High resistance)
Shift solenoid valve S4
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.064 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P0982: Range check (Low resistance)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Shift solenoid valve S4
ON
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
P0983: Range check (High resistance)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Shift solenoid valve S4
OFF
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1287
05-1098
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0982: Range check (Low resistance)
8 Ω or less
Shift solenoid valve S4 resistance
P0983: Range check (High resistance)
Shift solenoid valve S4 resistance
100 kΩ or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Resistance: 11 to 15 Ω at 20C (68F)
Shift solenoid valve S4
WIRING DIAGRAM
E1
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
ECM
+B
10
S4
E8
L-W
Y
S4
3
CPU
G31165
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(S4)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
(a)
S4
(b)
E1
G26426
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
3 - Body ground
11 to 15 Ω
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1288
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1099
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
S4
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
Connect the transmission connector to the transaxle.
Disconnect the connector from the ECM.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
E8 - 10 (S4) - Body ground
11 to 15 Ω
ECM:
C82158
C91565
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
3
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(S4)
(-)
Shift Solenoid Valve S4:
(a)
(b)
(+)
C90639
Remove the shift solenoid valve S4.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
Solenoid Connector (S4) - Solenoid
Body (S4)
11 to 15 Ω
(c)
Connect positive (+) lead to the terminal of solenoid connector, negative (-) lead to the solenoid body.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(S4)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-37 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1289
05-1 100
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05C18-12
DTC
P0985
SHIFT SOLENOID ”E” CONTROL CIRCUIT
LOW (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE SR)
DTC
P0986
SHIFT SOLENOID ”E” CONTROL CIRCUIT
HIGH (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE SR)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Shifting from 1st to 5th is performed in combination with ”ON” and ”OFF” operation of the shift solenoid valves
SL1, SL2, SL3, S4 and SR which is controlled by the ECM. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the
shift solenoid valves, the ECM controls the remaining normal shift solenoid valve to allow the vehicle to be
operated smoothly (Fail safe function).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0985
ECM detects short in solenoid valve SR circuit 2 times when
solenoid valve SR is operated (1-trip detection logic)
Short in shift solenoid valve SR circuit
Shift solenoid valve SR
ECM
P0986
ECM detects open in solenoid valve SR circuit 2 times when
solenoid valve SR is not operated (1-trip detection logic)
Open in shift solenoid valve SR circuit
Shift solenoid valve SR
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. When there is an open or
short circuit in any shift solenoid valve circuit, the ECM detects the problem and illuminates the MIL and
stores the DTC. And the ECM performs the fail-safe function and turns the other shift solenoid valves in good
condition ”ON/OFF” (In case of an open or short circuit, the ECM stops sending current to the circuit.)
(see page 05-1030 ).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
P0985: Shift solenoid valve SR/Range check (Low resistance)
P0986: Shift solenoid valve SR/Range check (High resistance)
Shift solenoid valve SR
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.064 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P0985: Range check (Low resistance)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Shift solenoid valve SR
ON
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
P0986: Range check (High resistance)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Shift solenoid valve SR
OFF
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1290
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-1 101
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0985: Range check (Low resistance)
8 Ω or less
Shift solenoid valve SR resistance
P0986: Range check (High resistance)
Shift solenoid valve SR resistance
100 kΩ or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Resistance: 11 to 15 Ω at 20C (68F)
Shift solenoid valve SR
WIRING DIAGRAM
E1
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
ECM
+B
9
SR
E8
L-B
V
SR
9
CPU
G31165
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(SR)
(a)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
(b)
E1
SR
G26426
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
9 - Body ground
11 to 15 Ω
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1291
05-1 102
2
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
Connect the transmission connector to the transaxle.
Disconnect the connector from the ECM.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
E8 - 9 (SR) - Body ground
11 to 15 Ω
SR
ECM:
C82158
C91565
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
3
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SR)
(+)
Shift Solenoid Valve SR:
(a)
(b)
(-)
C90640
Remove the shift solenoid valve SR.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
Solenoid Connector (SR) - Solenoid
Body (SR)
11 to 15 Ω
(c)
Connect positive (+) lead to the terminal of solenoid connector, negative (-) lead to the solenoid body.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SR)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-37 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1292
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P2716
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1 103
05C19-27
PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID ”D”
ELECTRICAL (SHIFT SOLENOID SLT)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Line Pressure
Control Pressure
Current Flow to Solenoid D02290
ON
OFF
The linear solenoid valve (SLT) controls the transmission line
pressure for smooth transmission operation based on signals
from the throttle position sensor and the vehicle speed sensor.
The ECM adjusts the duty cycle of the SLT solenoid valve to
control hydraulic line pressure coming from the primary regulator valve. Appropriate line pressure assures smooth shifting
with varying engine outputs.
(*): Duty Ratio
The duty ratio is the ratio of the period of continuity in one cycle.
For example, if A is the period of continuity in one cycle, and B
is the period of non-continuity, then
Duty Ratio=A/(A+B) x 100 (%)
1 cycle
BE4056
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Condition (a) or (b) below is detected 1 sec. or more:
(1-trip detection logic)
(a) SLT- terminal: 0V
(b) SLT- terminal: 12V
P2716
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SLT circuit
Shift solenoid valve SLT
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
When an open or short in the linear solenoid valve (SLT) circuit is detected, the ECM interprets this as a fault.
The ECM will turn ON the MIL and store the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P2716: Shift solenoid valve SLT/Range check
Shift solenoid valve SLT
Continuous
1 sec.
Immediate
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Solenoid current cut status
Not cut
Battery voltage
11 V or more
CPU commanded duty ratio to SLT
19% or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Solenoid status from IC
Fail (Open or short)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1293
05-1 104
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Resistance: 5.0 to 5.6 Ω at 20C (68F)
Shift solenoid valve SLT
WIRING DIAGRAM
E1 Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
G
SLT+
Y-R
2
ECM
+B
13
E8
SLT+
GR
8
Y-B
SLT-
12
SLTE8
G31770
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(SLT)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
(a)
SLT+
(b)
E1
SLT-
G26426
(c)
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
2 (SLT+) - 8 (SLT-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (SLT+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
8 (SLT-) - Body ground
↑
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1294
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
05-1 105
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E8
E7
SLT+
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
ECM:
SLT-
C82158
C91565
(d)
Connect the transmission wire connector to the transaxle.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
E8 - 13 (SLT+) - E8 - 12 (SLT-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 13 (SLT+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E8 - 12 (SLT-) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
3
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SLT)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve SLT:
1
2
(c)
2
1
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve (SLT).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
1-2
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Connect the positive (+) lead with a 21 W bulb to terminal
2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solenoid
valve connector, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
(+)
G20767
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SLT)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-37 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1295
05-1 106
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
0527R-38
DTC
P2769
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID
CIRCUIT LOW (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
DSL)
DTC
P2770
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID
CIRCUIT HIGH (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
DSL)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The shift solenoid valve DSL is turned ”ON” and ”OFF” by signals from the ECM in order to control the hydraulic pressure operation, the lock-up relay valve, which then the controls operation of the lock-up clutch.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2769
ECM detects short in solenoid valve DSL circuit (0.1 sec.)
when solenoid valve DSL is operated (2-trip detection logic)
Short in shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Shift solenoid valve DSL
ECM
P2770
ECM detects open in solenoid valve DSL circuit (0.1 sec.)
when solenoid valve DSL is not operated (2-trip detection
logic)
Open in shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Shift solenoid valve DSL
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Torque converter lock-up is controlled by the ECM based on engine rpm, engine load, engine temperature,
vehicle speed, transmission temperature, and shift range selection. The ECM determines the lock-up status
of the torque converter by comparing the engine rpm (NE) to the input turbine rpm (NT). The ECM calculates
the actual transmission gear by comparing input turbine rpm (NT) to counter gear rpm (NC). When conditions
are appropriate, the ECM requests ”lock-up” by applying control voltage to shift solenoid DSL. When the
DSL is opened, solenoid DSL applies pressure to the lock-up relay valve and locks the torque converter
clutch. If the ECM detects an open or short in the DSL solenoid circuit, the ECM interprets this as a fault in
the DSL solenoid or circuit. The ECM will turn on the MIL and store the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
P2769: Shift solenoid valve DSL/Range check (Low resistance)
P2770: Shift solenoid valve DSL/Range check (High resistance)
Shift solenoid valve DSL
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.064 sec.
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
2 driving cycles
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P2769: Range check (Low resistance)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Shift solenoid valve DSL
ON
Solenoid current cut status
Not cut
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1296
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-1 107
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
P2770: Range check (High resistance)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-1007
Shift solenoid valve DSL
ON
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2769: Range check (Low resistance)
8 Ω or less
Shift solenoid valve DSL resistance
P2770: Range check (High resistance)
Shift solenoid valve DSL resistance
100 kΩ or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Resistance: 11 to 13 Ω at 20C (68F)
Shift solenoid valve DSL
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
E1
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
+B
SB
Y-G
10
11 DSL
E8
CPU
DSL
G31165
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(DSL)
(a)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
(b)
E1
DSL
G26426
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
10 - Body ground
11 to 13 Ω
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1297
05-1 108
2
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
E8
ECM:
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
DSL
C82158
C91565
Connect the transmission wire connector.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
E8 - 11 (DSL) - Body ground
11 to 13 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-24 )
3
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(DSL)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve DSL:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
Solenoid Connector (DSL) - Solenoid
Body (DSL)
11 to 13 Ω
(c)
(-)
(+)
C90646
Remove the shift solenoid valve DSL.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Connect positive (+) lead to the terminal of solenoid connector, negative (-) lead to the solenoid body.
OK:
The solenoid valve makes an operating noise.
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(DSL)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-37 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1298
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-997
05EJV-07
ROAD TEST
1.
(a)
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Based on the result of the customer problem analysis, try to reproduce the symptoms. If the problem
is that the transaxle does not shift up, shift down, or the shift point is too high or too low, conduct the
following road test referring to the automatic shift schedule and simulate the problem symptoms.
2.
ROAD TEST
NOTICE:
Perform the test at the ATF (Automatic Transmission Fluid) temperature 50 to 80°C (122 to 176°F) in
the normal operation.
(a) D position test:
Shift into the D position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points.
(1) Check up-shift operation.
Check that 1 → 2, 2 → 3, 3 → 4 and 4 → 5th up-shifts take place, and that the shift points conform
to the automatic shift schedule (see page 03-51 ).
HINT:
5th Gear Up-shift Prohibition Control
Engine coolant temperature is 68 °C (154 °F) or less and vehicle speed is at 70 km/h (43 mph) or less.
ATF temperature is -2 °C (28 °F) or less.
4th Gear Up-shift Prohibition Control
Engine coolant temperature is 65 °C (149 °F) or less and vehicle speed is at 55 km/h (34 mph) or less.
5th and 4th Gear Lock-up Prohibition Control
Brake pedal is depressed.
Accelerator pedal is released.
Engine coolant temperature is 60 °C (140 °F) or less.
(2)
(3)
Check for shift shock and slip.
Check for shock and slip at the 1 → 2, 2 → 3, 3 → 4 and 4 → 5th up-shifts.
Check for abnormal noise and vibration.
Check for abnormal noise and vibration when up-shifting from 1 → 2, 2 → 3, 3 → 4 and 4 → 5
while driving with the shift lever in the D position, and check while driving in the lock-up condition.
HINT:
The check for the cause of abnormal noise and vibration must be done thoroughly as it could also be due
to loss of balance in the differential, torque converter clutch, etc.
(4) Check kick-down operation.
Check vehicle speeds when the 2nd to 1st, 3rd to 2nd, 4th to 3rd, and 5th to 4th kick-downs take
place while driving with the shift lever in the D position. Confirm that each speed is within the
applicable vehicle speed range indicated in the automatic shift schedule (see page 03-51 ).
(5) Check abnormal shock and slip at kick-down.
(6) Check the lock-up mechanism.
Drive in D position (5th gear), at a steady speed (lock-up ON).
Lightly depress the accelerator pedal and check that the engine speed does not change
abruptly.
HINT:
There is no lock-up function in the 1st, 2nd and 3rd gear.
4th lock-up operates while uphill-downhill control is active in the D position.
If there is a big jump in engine speed, there is no lock-up.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1187
05-998
(b)
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
4 position (O/D OFF) test:
Shift into the 4 position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points.
(1) Check up-shift operation.
Check that the 1 → 2, 2 → 3 and 3 → 4 up-shift takes place and that the shift point conforms
to the automatic shift schedule (see page 03-51 ).
HINT:
There is no 5th up-shift in the 4 position.
(2) Check engine braking.
While driving in the 4 position and 4th gear, release the accelerator pedal and check the engine
braking effect.
(3) Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and deceleration, and for shock at up-shift and
down-shift.
(c)
3 position test:
Shift into the 3 position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points.
(1) Check up-shift operation.
Check that the 1 → 2 and 2 → 3 up-shift takes place and that the shift point conforms to the automatic shift schedule (see page 03-51 ).
HINT:
There is no 4th up-shift and lock-up in the 3 position.
(2) Check engine braking.
While running in the 3 position and 3rd gear, release the accelerator pedal and check the engine
braking effect.
(3) Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and deceleration, and for shock at up-shift and
down-shift.
(d)
2 position test:
Shift into the 2 position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points.
(1) Check up-shift operation.
Check that the 1 → 2 up-shift takes place and that the shift point conforms to the automatic shift
schedule (see page 03-51 ).
HINT:
There is no 3rd up-shift and lock-up in the 2 position.
(2) Check engine braking.
While running in the 2 position and 2nd gear, release the accelerator pedal and check the engine
braking effect.
(3) Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and deceleration, and for shock at up-shift and
down-shift.
(e)
L position test:
Shift into the L position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points.
(1) Check no up-shift.
While running in the L position, check that there is no up-shift to 2nd gear.
HINT:
There is no lock-up in the L position.
(2) Check engine braking.
While running in the L position, release the accelerator pedal and check the engine braking effect.
(3) Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and deceleration.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1188
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-999
(f)
R position test:
Shift into the R position, lightly depress the accelerator pedal, and check that the vehicle moves backward without any abnormal noise or vibration.
CAUTION:
Before conducting this test ensure that the test area is free from people and obstruction.
(g)
P position test:
Stop the vehicle on a grade (more than 5°) and after shifting into the P position, release the parking
brake. Then, check that the parking lock pawl holds the vehicle in place.
(h)
Uphill/downhill control function test:
(1) Check that the gear does not up-shift to the 4th or 5th gear while the vehicle is driving uphill.
(2) Check that the gear automatically down-shifts from the 5th to 4th or from the 4th to 3rd gear when
brake is applied while the vehicle is driving downhill.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1189
05-992
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EJU-06
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
(a)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECT (Electronic controlled automatic transmission/transaxle) is an automatic transmission/transaxle that electronically controls shift timing using the ECM. The ECM detects electrical signals that indicate engine and driving conditions, controls the shift point, and selects the appropriate shift pattern
based on driver habits and road conditions. As a result, fuel efficiency and power transmission/transaxle performance are improved.
Shift shock has been reduced by controlling the engine and transmission/transaxle simultaneously.
In addition, the ECT has the following features:
Diagnostic function.
Fail-safe function when a malfunction occurs.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1182
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-991
05EJT-05
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
The configuration of the electronic control system in the U151E/U151F automatic transaxles is as shown
in the following chart.
NE
Crankshaft Position Sensor
SL1
Engine Coolant
Temperature Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor
THW
SL2
VTA1, 2
Shift Solenoid Valve SL1
Shift Solenoid Valve SL2
VC
Transmission Control Switch
(2 ⇔ L Position)
L
SL3
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Shift Solenoid Valve SL3
NSW
R, D, 3, 2
SLT
Transmission Control Switch
(O/D Main Switch)
ODMS
ECM
Speed Sensor
S4
Shift Solenoid Valve SLT
Shift Solenoid Valve S4
Skid Control ECU
DSL
Combination Meter
SPD
SR
Counter Gear Speed Sensor
(Speed Sensor NC)
NC
Input Turbine Speed Sensor
(Speed Sensor NT)
NT
Stop Lamp Switch Assy
Shift Solenoid Valve SR
W
MIL
(Malfunction Indicator Lamp)
SIL
DLC3
(Data Link Connector 3)
STP
TC
ATF (Automatic Transmission
Fluid) Temperature Sensor
Shift Solenoid Valve DSL
THO1
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1181
05-988
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EK8-06
PART AND SYSTEM NAME LIST
This reference list indicates the part names used in this manual along with their definitions.
Part and system name
Definition
Toyota HCAC system, Hydrocarbon adsorptive Catalyst
(HCAC) system, HC adsorptive three-way catalyst
HC adsorptive three-way catalytic converter
Variable Valve Timing sensor, VVT sensor
Camshaft position sensor
Variable valve timing system, VVT system
Camshaft timing control system
Camshaft timing oil control valve, Oil control valve OCV,
VVT, VSV
Camshaft timing oil control valve
Variable timing and lift, VVTL
Camshaft timing and lift control
Crankshaft position sensor ”A”
Crankshaft position sensor
Engine speed sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
THA
Intake air temperature
Knock control module
Engine knock control module
Knock sensor
Engine knock sensor
Mass or volume air flow circuit
Mass air flow sensor circuit
Vacuum sensor
Manifold air pressure sensor
Internal control module, Control module, Engine control
ECU, PCM
Power train control module
FC idle
Deceleration fuel cut
Idle air control valve
Idle speed control
VSV for CCV, Canister close valve VSV for canister control
Evaporative emissions canister vent valve
VSV for EVAP, Vacuum switching valve assembly No. 1,
EVAP VAV, Purge VSV
Evaporative emissions canister purge valve
VSV for pressure switching valve, Bypass VSV
Evaporative emission pressure switching valve
Vapor pressure sensor, EVAP pressure sensor, Evaporative
emission control system pressure sensor
Fuel tank pressure sensor
Charcoal canister
Evaporative emissions canister
ORVR system
On-boad refueling vapor recovery system
Intake manifold runner control
Intake manifold tuning system
Intake manifold runner valve, IMRV, IACV (runner valve)
Intake manifold tuning valve
Intake control VSV
Intake manifold tuning solenoid valve
AFS
Air fuel ratio sensor
O2 sensor
Heater oxygen sensor
Oxygen sensor pumping current circuit
Oxygen sensor output signal
Oxygen sensor reference ground circuit
Oxygen sensor signal ground
Accel position sensor
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Throttle actuator control motor, Actuator control motor, Electronic throttle motor, Throttle control motor
Electronic throttle actuator
Electronic throttle control system, Throttle actuator control
system
Electronic throttle control system
Throttle/pedal position sensor, Throttle/pedal position switch,
Throttle position sensor/switch
Throttle position sensor
Turbo press sensor
Turbocharger pressure sensor
Turbo VSV
Turbocharger pressure control solenoid valve
P/S pressure switch
Power-steering pressure switch
VSV for ACM
Active control engine mount
Speed sensor, Vehicle speed sensor ”A”, Speed sensor for
skid control ECU
Vehicle speed sensor
ATF temperature sensor, Trans. fluid temp. sensor, ATF
temperature sensor ”A”
Transmission fluid temperature sensor
Electronic controlled automatic transmission, ECT
Electronically controlled automatic
Intermediate shaft speed sensor ”A”
Counter gear speed sensor
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1178
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
Part and system name
05-989
Definition
Output speed sensor
Output shaft speed sensor
Input speed sensor, Input turbine speed sensor ”A”, Speed
sensor (NT), Turbine speed sensor
Input turbine speed sensor
PNP switch, NSW
Park/neutral position switch
Pressure control solenoid
Transmission pressure control solenoid
Shift solenoid
Transmission shift solenoid valve
Transmission control switch, Shift lock control unit
Shift lock control module
Engine immobilizer system, Immobilizer system
Vehicle anti-theft system
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1179
05-996
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
0527I-44
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
Automatic Transaxle
System Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
:
VIN
Production Date
Customer’s Name
/
/
Licence plate No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
Date Problem
Occurred
/
How Often Does
Problem Occur?
/
Intermittent (
Continuous
Vehicle does not move (
No up-shift
No down-shift
Any position
1st → 2nd
(
km
mile
Odometer Reading
/
(
5th → 4th
times a day)
particular position)
2nd → 3rd
3rd → 4th
4th → 3rd
4th → 5th)
3rd → 2nd
2nd → 1st)
Lock-up malfunction
Shift point too high or too low
Symptoms
Harsh engagement (
N→D
Lock-up
Any drive position)
Slip or shudder
No kick-down
Others
Check Item
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
Normal
1st Time
Normal code
Malfunction code (DTC
)
2nd Time
Normal code
Malfunction code (DTC
)
Remains ON
DTC Check
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1186
05-1034
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
0527K-49
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a DTC is displayed during the DTC check, check the parts listed in the table below and proceed to the page
given.
HINT:
*1 : ... MIL (Malfunction Indicator Lamp) light up
*2 : ... Mark means ECM memorizes the malfunction code if the ECM detects the DTC detection
condition.
This DTC may be output when the clutch, brake and gear components etc. inside the automatic transaxle are damaged.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL *1
Memory *2
P0500
(05-578 )
Vehicle Speed Sensor ”A”
Combination meter
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor circuit
Vehicle speed sensor
ECM
P0705
(05-1036 )
Transmission Range Sensor Circuit Malfunction (PRNDL Input)
Open or short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
P0710
(05-1042 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Circuit
Open or short in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
P0711
(05-1046 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Performance
Open or short in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
P0712
(05-1042 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Circuit Low Input
Short in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
P0713
(05-1042 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Circuit High Input
Open in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
Turbine Speed Sensor Circuit No
Signal
Open or short in transmission revolution sensor NT (speed
sensor NT) circuit
Transmission revolution sensor NT (speed sensor NT)
ECM
Automatic transaxle assembly
Brake Switch ”B” Circuit High
Short in stop light switch signal circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
P0741
(05-1056 )
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve DSL)
Shift solenoid valve DSL remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve DSL
Torque converter clutch
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
Line pressure is too low
ECM
P0746
(05-1061 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”A”
Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL1)
Shift solenoid valve SL1 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve SL1
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
P0748
(05-1065 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”A”
Electrical
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL1)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL1
ECM
P0717
(05-1049 )
P0724
(05-1052 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1224
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-1035
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
Shift Solenoid ”D” Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve S4)
Shift solenoid valve S4 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve S4
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
P0771
(05-1072 )
Shift Solenoid ”E” Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve SR)
Shift solenoid valve SR remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve SR
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
P0776
(05-1077 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”B”
Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL2)
Shift solenoid valve SL2 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve SL2
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
P0778
(05-1082 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”B”
Electrical
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL2)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL2
ECM
P0793
(05-1085 )
Intermediate Shaft Speed Sensor ”A”
Open or short in transmission revolution sensor NC (speed
sensor NC) circuit
Transmission revolution sensor NC (speed sensor NC)
ECM
P0796
(05-1089 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”C”
Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL3)
Shift solenoid valve SL3 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve SL3
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
P0798
(05-1094 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”C”
Electrical
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL3)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL3 circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL3
ECM
P0982
(05-1097 )
Shift Solenoid ”D” Control Circuit
Low (Shift Solenoid Valve S4)
Short in shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Shift solenoid valve S4
ECM
P0983
(05-1097 )
Shift Solenoid ”D” Control Circuit
High (Shift Solenoid Valve S4)
Open in shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Shift solenoid valve S4
ECM
P0985
(05-1100)
Shift Solenoid ”E” Control Circuit
Low (Shift Solenoid Valve SR)
Short in shift solenoid valve SR circuit
Shift solenoid valve SR
ECM
P0986
(05-1100)
Shift Solenoid ”E” Control Circuit
High (Shift Solenoid Valve SR)
Open in shift solenoid valve SR circuit
Shift solenoid valve SR
ECM
P2716
(05-1103)
Pressure Control Solenoid ”D”
Electrical
(Shift Solenoid Valve SLT)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SLT circuit
Shift solenoid valve SLT
ECM
P2769
(05-1106)
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Circuit Low
(Shift Solenoid Valve DSL)
Short in shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Shift solenoid valve DSL
ECM
P2770
(05-1106)
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Circuit High
(Shift Solenoid Valve DSL)
Open in shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Shift solenoid valve DSL
ECM
P0766
(05-1068 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1225
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-993
0527H-45
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
The ECM of this system is connected to the multiplex communication system. Therefore, before starting troubleshooting, make sure to check that there is no trouble in the multiplex communication system.
The hand-held tester can be used at steps 3, 4, 6, and 9.
1
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
2
Customer Problem Analysis (SEE PAGE 05-996 )
3
Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to DLC3
4
Check and Clear DTC and Freeze Frame Data (SEE PAGE 05-1026 )
5
Visual Inspection
6
Setting the Check Mode Diagnosis (SEE PAGE 05-1028 )
7
Problem Symptom Confirmation (SEE PAGE 05-997 )
Symptom does not occur: Go to step 8
Symptom occur: Go to step 9
8
Symptom Simulation (SEE PAGE 01-26 )
9
DTC Check (SEE PAGE 05-1026 )
DTC is not output: Go to step 10
DTC is output: Go to step 17
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1183
05-994
10
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
Basic Inspection (SEE PAGE 40-2 , 40-1 1 and 40-71 )
NG
Go to step 19
OK
11
Mechanical System Test (SEE PAGE 05-1000 )
NG
Go to step 16
OK
12
Hydraulic Test (SEE PAGE 05-1002 )
NG
Go to step 16
OK
13
Manual Shifting Test (SEE PAGE 05-1004 )
NG
Go to step 15
OK
14
Problem Symptoms Table Chapter 1 (SEE PAGE 05-1016 )
NG
Go to step 18
OK
15
Problem Symptoms Table Chapter 2 (SEE PAGE 05-1016 )
16
Part Inspection
Go to step 19
17
DTC Chart (SEE PAGE 05-1034 )
18
Circuit Inspection
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1184
DIAGNOSTICS
19
Repair or Replace
20
Confirmation Test
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-995
End
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1185
05-990
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
0527L-45
LOCATION
Combination Meter
MIL (Malfunction Indicator Lamp)
ECM
Transmission Control Switch
(O/D Main Switch)
Pattern Select Switch
(ECT SNOW Switch)
Stop Lamp Switch
Assy
DLC3
(Data Link Connector 3)
Transmission Control Switch
(2 ⇔ L Position)
Transmission Revolution Sensor NT
(Speed Sensor NT)
Shift Solenoid Valve SL1
Transmission Revolution Sensor NC
(Speed Sensor NC)
Shift Solenoid Valve SLT
Shift Solenoid Valve SL3
Shift Solenoid Valve SR
Transmission Wire
(ATF Temperature Sensor)
Park/neutral Position
Switch Assy
Shift Solenoid Valve DSL
Shift Solenoid Valve S4
Shift Solenoid Valve SL2
G32074
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1180
05-986
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
[ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05C0T-30
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
Perform the RESET MEMORY (AT initialization) when replacing the automatic transaxle assy, engine
assy or ECM (see page 05-1005 ).
HINT:
Initialization can not be completed by only disconnecting the battery terminal.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1176
05-1016
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
0527M-48
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
If a normal code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check although the trouble still occurs, check
the electrical circuits for each symptom in the order given in the charts on the following pages and proceed
to the page given for troubleshooting.
The Matrix Chart is divided into 2 chapters.
1.
Chapter 1: Electronic Circuit Matrix Chart
Refer to the table below when the trouble cause is considered to be electrical.
If the instruction ”Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on matrix chart” is given in the flow chart
of each circuit, proceed to the circuit with the next highest number in the table to continue the check.
If the trouble still occurs even though there are no abnormalities in any of the other circuits, check and
replace the ECM.
HINT:
*1: When the circuit on which mark *1 is attached is a malfunction, DTC could be output (see page 05-1026 ).
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
No down-shift
(A particular gear, from 1st to 4th gear, is not down-shifted)
1. Shift solenoid valve (SL1) circuit *1
2. Shift solenoid valve (SL2) circuit *1
3. Shift solenoid valve (SL3) circuit *1
4. Shift solenoid valve (SR) circuit *1
5. ECM
05-1061
05-1077
05-1089
05-1072
01-36
No down-shift (5th → 4th)
1. Transmission control switch (O/D OFF) circuit
2. Shift solenoid valve (S4) circuit *1
3. ECM
05-1109
05-1068
01-36
No up-shift
(A particular gear, from 1st to 4th gear, is not up-shifted)
1. Shift solenoid valve (SL1) circuit *1
2. Shift solenoid valve (SL2) circuit *1
3. ECM
05-1061
05-1077
01-36
No up-shift (4th → 5th)
1. Transmission control switch (O/D OFF) circuit
2. Shift solenoid valve (S4) circuit *1
3. ECM
05-1109
05-1068
01-36
No lock-up
1. Shift solenoid valve (DSL) circuit *1
2. Stop light switch circuit *1
3. Engine coolant temp. sensor circuit *1
4. ECM
05-1056
05-1052
05-412
01-36
No lock-up off
1. Shift solenoid valve (DSL) circuit *1
2. ECM
05-1056
01-36
Shift point too high or too low
1. Throttle position sensor circuit *1
2. Shift solenoid valve (SLT) circuit *1
3. ECM
05-412
05-1103
01-36
Up-shift to 5th from 4th while shift lever is D (O/D OFF) position
1. Transmission control switch (O/D OFF) circuit
2. ECM
05-1109
01-36
Up-shift to 5th from 4th while engine is cold
1. Engine coolant temp. sensor circuit *1
2. ECM
05-412
01-36
Up-shift to 2nd from 1st while shift lever is L position
1. Transmission control switch (2 ⇔ L position) circuit *1
2. ECM
05-1036
01-36
Harsh engagement (N → D)
1. Shift solenoid valve (SL1) circuit *1
2. ECM
05-1061
01-36
Harsh engagement (Lock-up)
1. Shift solenoid valve (SL2) circuit *1
2. ECM
05-1077
01-36
Harsh engagement (Any driving position)
1. Shift solenoid valve (SLT) circuit *1
2. ECM
05-1103
01-36
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1206
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
Poor acceleration
1. Shift solenoid valve (SLT) circuit *1
2. ECM
No kick-down
ECM
05-1017
05-1103
01-36
01-36
*1
05-1056
01-36
Engine stalls when starting off or stopping
1. Shift solenoid valve (DSL) circuit
2. ECM
Malfunction in shifting
1. Park/neutral position switch circuit *1
2. Transmission control switch (O/D OFF) circuit
3. ECM
05-1036
05-1109
01-36
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1207
05-1018
2.
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
Chapter 2: On-Vehicle Repair and Off-Vehicle Repair
(: U151E, U151F AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual Pub. No. RM1021U)
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Vehicle does not move in forward position and in reverse positions
1. Valve body assy
2. U/D brake (B3)
3. Torque converter clutch
40-44
40-29
Vehicle does not move in R position
1. Valve body assy
2. Reverse clutch (C2)
3. 1st & reverse brake (B2)
40-44
No up-shift (1st → 2nd)
1. Valve body assy
2. 2nd & O/D brake (B1)
40-44
No up-shift (2nd → 3rd)
1. Valve body assy
2. Direct and O/D clutch (C0)
40-44
No up-shift (3rd → 4th)
1. Valve body assy
2. 2nd & O/D brake (B1)
40-44
No up-shift (4th → 5th)
1. Valve body assy
2. U/D clutch (C3)
40-44
No down-shift (5th → 4th)
Valve body assy
40-44
No down-shift (4th → 3rd)
Valve body assy
40-44
No down-shift (3rd → 2nd)
Valve body assy
40-44
No down-shift (2nd → 1st)
Valve body assy
40-44
No lock-up or No lock-up off
1. Valve body assy
2. Torque converter clutch
40-44
40-29
Harsh engagement (N → D)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
40-44
Harsh engagement (Lock-up)
1. Valve body assy
2. Torque converter clutch
40-44
40-29
Harsh engagement (N → R)
1.
2.
3.
4.
40-44
Harsh engagement (1st →2nd → 3rd → 4th → 5th)
Valve body assy
40-44
Harsh engagement (1st → 2nd)
1. Valve body assy
2. 2nd & O/D brake (B1)
40-44
Harsh engagement (2nd → 3rd)
1. Valve body assy
2. C0 accumulator
3. Direct and O/D clutch (C0)
40-44
Harsh engagement (3rd → 4th)
1. Valve body assy
2. 2nd & O/D brake (B1)
40-44
Harsh engagement (4th → 5th)
1. Valve body assy
2. C3 accumulator
3. U/D clutch (C3)
40-44
Harsh engagement (5th → 4th)
1. Valve body assy
2. B3 accumulator
40-44
Valve body assy
C1 accumulator
Forward clutch (C1)
One-way clutch No.1 (F1)
U/D one-way clutch (F2)
Valve body assy
C2 accumulator
Reverse clutch (C2)
1st & reverse brake (B2)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1208
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1019
Slip or shudder (Forward and reverse: After warm-up)
1. Valve body assy
2. Oil strainer
3. Direct and O/D clutch (C0)
4. Forward clutch (C1)
5. U/D clutch (C3)
6. 2nd & O/D brake (B1)
7. U/D brake (B3)
8. One-way clutch No.1 (F1)
9. U/D one-way clutch (F2)
10.Torque converter clutch
40-44
40-44
40-29
Slip or shudder (Particular position: Just after engine starts)
Torque converter clutch
40-29
Slip or shudder (R position)
1. Reverse clutch (C2)
2. 1st & reverse brake (B2)
Slip or shudder (1st)
1. Forward clutch (C1)
2. One-way clutch No.1 (F1)
3. U/D one-way clutch (F2)
Slip or shudder (2nd)
2nd & O/D brake (B1)
Slip or shudder (3rd)
Direct and O/D clutch (C0)
Slip or shudder (4th)
2nd & O/D brake (B1)
Slip or shudder (5th)
U/D clutch (C3)
No engine braking (1st − 4th: D position)
U/D brake (B3)
No engine braking (1st: L (1) position)
1. Valve body assy
2. 1st & reverse brake (B2)
40-44
No engine braking (2nd: 2 position)
1. Valve body assy
2. 2nd & O/D brake (B1)
40-44
No engine braking (3rd: 3 position)
U/D brake (B3)
Poor acceleration (All positions)
Torque converter clutch
Poor acceleration (5th)
1. U/D clutch (C3)
2. U/D planetary gear unit
Engine stalls when starting off or stopping
Torque converter clutch
40-29
No kick-down
Valve body assy
40-44
40-29
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1209
05-1020
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05EK6-06
TERMINALS OF ECM
1.
ECM
E7
E8
E9
E6
E5
C80654
C91969
HINT:
Each ECM terminal’s standard voltage is shown in the table below.
In the table, first follow the information under ”Condition”. Look under ”Symbols (Terminal No.)” for the terminals to be inspected. The standard voltage between the terminals is shown under ”Specific Condition”.
Use the illustration above as a reference for the ECM terminals.
Symbols (Terminals No.)
P (E5-6)
(E5 6) - E1 (E9-1)
(E9 1)
N (E5-7)
(E5 7) - E1 (E9-1)
(E9 1)
L (E6-8)
(E6 8) - E1 (E9-1)
(E9 1)
2 (E6-9)
(E6 9) - E1 (E9-1)
(E9 1)
D (E6-10)
(E6 10) - E1 (E9-1)
(E9 1)
R (E6-11)
(E6 11) - E1 (E9-1)
(E9 1)
Wiring Color
V - BR
GR - BR
R - BR
G - BR
Y - BR
L - BR
SPD (E6-17) - E1 (E9-1)
Y - BR
STP (E6-19)
(E6 19) - E1 (E9-1)
(E9 1)
BR - BR
3 (E6-20)
(E6 20) - E1 (E9-1)
(E9 1)
P - BR
Terminal Description
P shift position
osition switch sig
signal
N shift position
osition switch sig
signal
L shift position
osition switch sigsig
nal
2 shift position
osition switch sigsig
nal
D shift position
osition switch sig
signal
R shift position
osition switch sig
signal
Speed signal
St lamp
Stop
l
switch
it h signal
i
l
3 shift position
osition switch sigsig
nal
Condition
Specified Condition
IG switch ON and shift lever P position
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON and shift lever except
P position
Below 1 V
IG switch ON and shift lever N position
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON and shift lever except
N position
Below 1 V
IG switch ON and shift lever L position
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON and shift lever except
L position
Below 1 V
IG switch ON and shift lever 2 and L
position
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON and shift lever except
2 and L position
Below 1 V
IG switch ON and shift lever D position
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON and shift lever except
D position
Below 1 V
IG switch ON and shift lever R position
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON and shift lever except
R position
Below 1 V
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 8)
Brake pedal is depressed
7.5 to 14 V
Brake pedal is released
Below 1.5 V
IG switch ON and shift lever 3 position
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON and shift lever except
3 position
Below 1 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1210
DIAGNOSTICS
NSW (E7-16)
(E7 16) - E1 (E9-1)
(E9 1)
DSL (E8-11) - E1 (E9-1)
B R - BR
B-R
-
P k neutral
Park
t l switch
it h signal
i
l
Y-G - BR
DSL solenoid signal
SR (E8
(E8-9)
9) - E1 (E9
(E9-1)
1)
L-B
L
B - BR
SR solenoid signal
ODMS (E5-16) - E1 (E9-1)
GR - BR
O/D main switch
↑
↑
S4 (E8
(E8-10)
10) - E1 (E9
(E9-1)
1)
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
↑
L-W
L
W - BR
S4 solenoid signal
05-1021
IG switch ON and shift lever P and
N position
Below 1 V
IG switch ON and shift lever except
P and N position
10 to 14 V
Vehicle speed 65 km/h (40 mph),
lock-up (ON to OFF)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 2)
IG switch ON
Below 1 V
3rd, 4th or 5th gear
10 to 14 V
1st or 2nd gear
Below 1 V
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON and press continuously O/D main switch
Below 1 V
IG switch ON
Below 1 V
5th gear
10 to 14 V
Except 5th gear
Below 1 V
SL3+ (E8-17) - SL3- (E8-16)
G-B - G-R
SL3 solenoid signal
Engine idle speed
Pulse generation
(See waveform 3)
SL2+ (E8-15) - SL2- (E8-14)
L-Y - L-R
SL2 solenoid signal
Engine idle speed
Pulse generation
(See waveform 4)
SL1+ (E8-19) - SL1- (E8-18)
R-B - B-W
SL1 solenoid signal
Engine idle speed
Pulse generation
(See waveform 5)
NC+ (E8-26) - NC- (E8-34)
R - W-G
Speed sensor (NC) signal
Vehicle speed 30 km/h (19 mph):
(3rd gear)
Engine speed 1,400 rpm
Pulse generation
(See waveform 6)
NT+ (E8-27) - NT- (E8-35)
W - R-W
Speed sensor (NT) signal
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 7)
SLT+ (E8-13) - SLT- (E8-12)
Y-R - Y-B
SLT solenoid signal
Engine idle speed
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
THO1 (E8-32) - E2 (E7-28)
G-Y - BR
ATF temperature sensor
signal
ATF temperature: 115 C (239 F)
or more
5 V/DIV
Below 1.5 V
Waveform 1
Reference:
Terminal
SLT+ - SLT-
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 1ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
GND
1 ms/DIV
G23426
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1211
05-1022
DIAGNOSTICS
10 V/DIV
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
Waveform 2
Reference:
Terminal
DSL - E1
Tool setting
10V/DIV, 100ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Vehicle speed 65 km/h (40 mph), lock-up (ON to OFF)
100 ms/DIV
C53420
C42677
5 V/DIV
Waveform 3
Reference:
Terminal
SL3+ - SL3-
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 1ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
GND
1 ms/DIV
G23426
5 V/DIV
Waveform 4
Reference:
Terminal
SL2+ - SL2-
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 1ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
GND
1 ms/DIV
G23426
5 V/DIV
Waveform 5
Reference:
Terminal
SL1+ - SL1-
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 1ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
GND
1 ms/DIV
G23426
1 V/DIV
Waveform 6
Reference:
Terminal
NC+ - NC-
Tool setting
1V/DIV, 1ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Vehicle speed 30 km/h (19 mph): (3rd gear)
Engine speed 1,400 rpm
1 ms/DIV
C93866
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1212
DIAGNOSTICS
5 V/DIV
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U151E/U151F)
05-1023
Waveform 7
Reference:
Terminal
NT+ - NT-
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 0.5ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph)
0.5 ms/DIV
C53419
C42920
5 V/DIV
Waveform 8
Reference:
Terminal
SPD - E1
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 20ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph)
20 ms/DIV
A05135
C53421
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1213
05-914
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05F33-05
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
1.
DTC CHECK (CHECK MODE)
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
Compared to the normal mode, the check mode has more sensing ability to detect malfunctions. Furthermore, the same diagnostic items which are detected in the normal mode can also be
detected in the check mode.
Hand-Held Tester
DLC3
G30830
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR3904
(a)
Procedure for Check Mode using the hand-held tester.
(1) Check the initial conditions.
Battery positive voltage 11 V or more
Throttle valve fully closed
Transaxle in the P or N position
A/C switch is off
(2) Turn the ignition switch off.
(3) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(4) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push
the hand-held tester main switch on.
(5) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/
CHECK MODE” (Check that the MIL flashes).
NOTICE:
All DTCs and freeze frame data recorded will be erased if:
1) the hand-held tester is used to change the ECM from
normal mode to check mode or vice-versa; or 2) during
check mode, the ignition switch is turned from ON to ACC
or OFF.
(6) Start the engine (MIL goes off after the engine
starts).
(7) Perform ”MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN” for the ECT
test (see page 05-902 ).
(Or, simulate the conditions of the malfunction described by the customer).
NOTICE:
Leave the ignition switch in the ON position until you have
checked the DTCs, etc.
(8) After simulating malfunction conditions, use the
hand-held tester diagnosis selector to check the
DTCs and freeze frame data, etc.
(9) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/
DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(10) After checking the DTC, inspect the applicable circuit.
(11) See page 05- 920 to confirm the details of the
DTCs.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1104
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-915
DTC CLEAR
When using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester:
Clearing the DTCs.
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester
to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push
the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch on.
(3) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/
DTC INFO/CLEAR CODES [YES] button”.
HINT:
When operating the OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or hand-held tester to erase the codes, the DTCs and
freeze frame data will be erased. (See the OBD II scan tool’s
instruction book for operating instructions.)
(b) When not using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester:
Clearing the DTCs.
(1) Disconnecting the battery terminal or remove the
EFI and ETCS fuses from the engine room J/B for
60 seconds or more. But if you disconnect the battery terminal, you should do the ”INITIALIZE” procedure.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1105
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-877
05F37-05
DEFINITION OF TERMS
Term
Definition
Monitor description
Description of what the ECM monitors and how it detects malfunctions (monitoring purpose and its details).
Related DTCs
A group of diagnostic trouble codes that are output by the ECM based on the same malfunction detection logic.
Typical enabling condition
Preconditions that allow the ECM to detect malfunctions.
With all preconditions satisfied, the ECM sets the DTC when the monitored value(s) exceeds the malfunction
threshold(s).
Sequence of operation
The priority order that is applied to monitoring, if multiple sensors and components are used to detect the malfunction.
While another sensor is being monitored, the next sensor or component will not be monitored until the previous
monitoring has concluded.
Required sensor/components
The sensors and components that are used by the ECM to detect malfunctions.
Frequency of operation
The number of times that the ECM checks for malfunctions per driving cycle.
”Once per driving cycle” means that the ECM detects malfunction only one time during a single driving cycle.
”Continuous” means that the ECM detects malfunction every time when enabling condition is met.
Duration
The minimum time that the ECM must sense a continuous deviation in the monitored value(s) before setting a
DTC. This timing begins after the ”typical enabling conditions” are met.
Malfunction thresholds
Beyond this value, the ECM will conclude that there is a malfunction and set a DTC.
MIL operation
MIL illumination timing after a defect is detected.
”Immediately” means that the ECM illuminates MIL the instant the ECM determines that there is a malfunction.
”2 driving cycle” means that the ECM illuminates MIL if the same malfunction is detected again in the 2nd driving
cycle.
Component operating range
Normal operation range of sensors and solenoids under normal driving conditions.
Use these ranges as a reference.
They cannot be used to judge if a sensor or solenoid is defective or not.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1067
05-910
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05F30-05
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
(a)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Description
(1) When troubleshooting OBD II vehicles, the only difference from the usual troubleshooting procedure
is that you need to connect an OBD II scan tool complying with SAE J1987 or a hand-held tester to the
vehicle, and read off various data output from the
vehicle’s ECM.
(2)
FI0534
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle’s onboard computer illuminate the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer detects a malfunction in the computer itself or
in the drive system components which affect the vehicle emissions. In addition to the MIL illuminating
when a malfunction is detected, the applicable
DTCs prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the
ECM memory (see page 05-920 ).
If the malfunction does not occur in 3 consecutive trips, the MIL
goes off but the DTCs remain in the ECM memory.
(3) To check the DTCs, connect the OBD II scan tool or
hand-held tester to the DLC3 of the vehicle. The
OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester also enables
you to erase the DTCs and check freeze frame data
and various forms of engine data (For instruction
book).
(4) The DTCs include SAE controlled codes and
Manufacturer controlled codes. SAE controlled
codes must be set as prescribed by the SAE, while
Manufacturer controlled codes can be set freely by
a manufacturer within the prescribed limits (see the
DTC chart on page 05-920 ).
(5) The diagnosis system operates in the normal mode
during the normal vehicle use, and also has a check
mode for technicians to simulate malfunction symptoms and perform troubleshooting. Most DTCs use
2 trip detection logic(*) to prevent erroneous detection. By switching the ECM to the check mode when
troubleshooting, the technician can cause the MIL
to illuminate for a malfunction that is only detected
once or momentarily (hand-held tester).
(6) *2 trip detection logic:
When a malfunction is first detected, the malfunction is temporarily stored in the ECM memory. If the
same malfunction is detected again during the second test drive, this second detection causes the
MIL to illuminate.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1100
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
D1
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-91 1
Inspect the DLC3.
The vehicle’s ECM uses ISO 9141-2 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of DLC3 complies with SAE
J1962 and matches the ISO 9141-2 format.
1 23 4 5 6 78
9 10111213141516
DLC3
A04550
Tester connection
7 (Bus Line) - 5 (Signal ground)
Condition
Specified condition
During communication
Pulse generation
4 (Chassis Ground) - Body
Always
1 Ω or less
5 (Signal Ground) - Body
Always
1 Ω or less
16 (B+) - Body
Always
9 to 14 V
HINT:
If your display shows UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE
when you have connected the cable of the OBD II scan tool or
hand-held tester to the DLC3, turned the ignition switch to the
ON position and operated the scan tool, there is a problem on
the vehicle side or tool side.
If the communication is normal when the tool is connected
to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on the original vehicle.
If the communication is still impossible when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in
the tool itself, so consult the Service Department listed in
the tool’s instruction manual.
(c) Measure the battery voltage.
Battery Voltage: 11 to 14 V
If voltage is below 11 V, recharge the battery before proceeding.
(d) Check the MIL.
(1) The MIL comes on when the ignition switch is turned
to the ON position and the engine is not running.
HINT:
If the MIL does not light up, troubleshoot the combination meter.
(2) When the engine is started, the MIL should go off.
If the lamp remains on, it means that the diagnosis
system has detected a malfunction or abnormality
in the system.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1101
05-918
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05F35-05
DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST
1.
DATA LIST
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Push the ”ON” button of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
(f)
When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST”.
(g) According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Item
Measurement Item/
Range (display)
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light SW Status/
ON or OFF
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
Brake Pedal is depressed: ON
Brake Pedal is released: OFF
-
PNP SW [NSW]
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
P and N: ON
Except P and N: OFF
When the shift lever position displayed on the hand-held tester differs from the actual position, adjustment of the PNP switch or the
shift cable may be incorrect.
HINT:
When the failure still occurs even
after adjusting these parts,
see page 05-922 .
LOW
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
L: ON
Except L: OFF
↑
2ND
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
2: ON
Except 2: OFF
↑
REVERSE
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
R: ON
Except R: OFF
↑
4TH/DRIVE
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
D: ON
Except D: OFF
↑
O/D SW Status/
ON or OFF
IG SW ON: ON
↓
O/D SW Push: OFF
↓
O/D SW Push: ON
-
Shift lever position is;
L: 1st
2: 1st or 2nd
3: 1st, 2nd or 3rd
D(O/D ON): 1st, 2nd, 3rd or 4th
(O/D)
-
OVERDRV CUT SW1
SHIFT
Actual Gear position/
1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th (O/D)
LOCK UP SOL
Lock Up Solenoid Status/
ON or OFF
Lock Up: ON
Except Lock Up: OFF
-
SOLENOID (SLT)
Shift Solenoid SLT Status/
ON or OFF
Accelerator pedal is depressed:
OFF
Accelerator pedal is released:
ON
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1108
DIAGNOSTICS
AT FLUID TEMP
SPD (NC)
ATF Temp. Sensor Value/
min.: -40C (-40F)
max.: 215C (419F)
Counter Gear Speed/
display: 50 r/min
-
05-919
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
After Stall Test;
Approx. 80C (176F)
Equal to ambient temperature
when the engine is cold
If the value is ”-40C (-40F)” or
”215C (419F)”, ATF temp. sensor circuit is opened or shorten.
[HINT]
4th (O/D) when shift lever position
is D position (After warming up the
engine);
Intermediate shaft speed (NC)
becomes close to the engine
speed.
-
2.
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method
to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Push the ”ON” button of the hand-held tester.
(f)
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/ACTIVE TEST”.
(g) According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SHIFT
[Test Details]
Operate the shift solenoid valve and set the each shift position by yourself.
[Vehicle Condition]
Less than 50 km/h (31 mph)
[Others]
Press ”→” button: Shift up
Press ”←” button: Shift down
Possible to check the operation of
the shift solenoid valves.
[Test Details]
Control the shift solenoid DSL to set the automatic transaxle to the
lock-up condition.
[Vehicle Condition]
Vehicle Speed: 58 km/h (36 mph) or more
Possible to check the DSL operation.
LOCK UP
LINE PRESS UP *
[Test Details]
Operate the shift solenoid SLT and raise the line pressure.
[Vehicle Condition]
Vehicle Stopped.
IDL: ON
[HINT]
OFF: Line pressure up (When the active test of ”LINE PRESS UP” is
performed, the ECM commands the SLT solenoid to turn off).
ON: No action (normal operation)
-
*: ”LINE PRESS UP” in the ACTIVE TEST is performed to check the line pressure changes by connecting
the SST to the automatic transaxle, which is used in the HYDRAULIC TEST (see page 05-891 ) as well.
HINT:
The pressure values in ACTIVE TEST and HYDRAULIC TEST are different from each other.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1109
05-912
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05F31-05
DTC CHECK/CLEAR
1.
DTC CHECK (NORMAL MODE)
NOTICE:
When the diagnostic system is switched from the normal
mode to the check mode, all the DTCs and freeze frame
data recorded in the normal mode will be erased. So before
switching modes, always check the DTCs and freeze frame
data, and note them down.
Hand-Held Tester
DLC3
G30830
(a)
Checking DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held
tester.
(1) Turn the ignition switch off.
(2) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester
to DLC3.
(3) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push
the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch on.
(4) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/
DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(5) Use the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to
check the DTCs and freeze frame data and note
them down (For operating instructions, see the
OBD II scan tool’s instruction book).
(6) See page 05-920 to confirm the details of the
DTCs.
NOTICE:
When simulating symptoms with an OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester) to check the DTCs, use the normal mode. For codes on the DTCs chart subject to ”2 trip
detection logic”, turn the ignition switch off after the symptom is simulated once. Then repeat the simulation process
again. When the problem has been simulated twice, the MIL
is indicated on the instrument panel and DTCs are recorded in the ECM.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1102
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-913
DTC CLEAR
When using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester:
Clearing the DTCs.
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester
to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push
the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch on.
(3) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/
DTC INFO/CLEAR CODES [YES] button”.
HINT:
When operating the OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or hand-held tester to erase the codes, the DTCs and
freeze frame data will be erased. (See the OBD II scan tool’s
instruction book for operating instructions.)
(b) When not using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester:
Clearing the DTCs.
(1) Disconnecting the battery terminal or remove the
EFI and ETCS fuses from the engine room J/B for
60 seconds or more. But if you disconnect the battery terminal, you should do the ”INITIALIZE” procedure.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1103
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-983
05ITR-02
PATTERN SELECT SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Multiplex network body ECU receives pattern select switch information, and sends it through the multiplex
communication system to the ECM.
ECT SNOW is the system that operates the throttle motor to control engine output to reduce skidding of the
driving wheels, guarantee takeoff acceleration, driving straightness and turning stability.
WIRING DIAGRAM
E4
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Pattern Select SW *
Center J/B
W-B
13
3F
8
3D
W-B
Y
4
3
Multiplex Network
Body ECU
15
B9 SNOW
IB
(*) Pattern Select Switch (ECT SNOW Switch)
When the ECT SNOW switch is pushed, the switch contact is made and the ECT SNOW mode is selected.
To cancel the ECT SNOW mode, push the ECT SNOW switch once again. The ECT SNOW mode is automatically cancelled when the ignition switch is turned ”OFF”.
G30835
G32449
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1173
05-984
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
DRIVING TEST
Start the engine.
Turn the ECT SNOW switch ”OFF” (Normal drive mode).
Confirm vehicle response by driving from a parked position to fully depressing the accelerator pedal.
Turn the ECT SNOW switch ”ON” and perform the same check as (c).
Confirm that there is a difference between ECT SNOW switch ”ON” and ”OFF”.
HINT:
Driving test should be done on a paved road (a nonskid road).
Make sure not to use the TRAC system when testing a vehicle equipped with one.
OK:
There is a difference in acceleration between ”ON” and ”OFF”.
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-904 )
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PATTERN SELECT SWITCH ASSY NO.1 BODY GROUND)
(a)
Wire Harness Side:
(Connector Front View):
(b)
Disconnect the connector of pattern select switch (ECT
SNOW switch).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
E4
NG
G23382
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
4 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
3
INSPECT PATTERN SELECT SWITCH ASSY NO.1
(a)
Switch Side:
(Connector Front View):
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Switch Condition
E4
Tester Connection
Press continuously
Pattern select switch
Below 1 Ω
3-4
Release
Pattern select switch
C82813
Specified Condition
D25463
NG
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE PATTERN SELECT SWITCH ASSY
NO.1
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1174
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
05-985
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PATTERN SELECT SWITCH ASSY NO.1 MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Connect the connector of pattern select switch (ECT
SNOW switch).
Disconnect the multiplex network body ECU connector.
Measure the resistance between terminals SNOW of multiplex network body ECU and body ground.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Press continuously
Pattern select switch
Release
Pattern select switch
Multiplex Network Body ECU:
Back Side:
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
B9 - 15 (SNOW) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
B9
B9
SNOW
G32072
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-904 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1175
05-916
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05F32-05
FAIL-SAFE CHART
1.
FAIL-SAFE
This function minimizes the loss of the ECT functions when any malfunction occurs in each sensor or solenoid.
(a) ATF (Automatic Transmission Fluid) temperature sensor:
When the ATF temperature sensor has a malfunction, O/D upshift is prohibited.
(b) Counter gear speed sensor NC (Speed sensor NC):
When the counter gear speed sensor has a malfunction, O/D upshift is prohibited.
(c) Shift solenoid valve DSL:
When the solenoid valve DSL has a malfunction, the current to the solenoid valve is stopped.
This stops lock-up control, then fuel economy decreases.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1106
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-917
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
(d) Shift solenoid valve SL1, SL2 and S4:
Fail safe function:
If either of the shift solenoid valve circuits develops an open or short, the ECM turns the other shift solenoid
”ON” and ”OFF” in order to shift into the gear positions shown in the table below.
Manual shifting as shown in the following table must be done (In case of a short circuit, the ECM stops sending the current to the short circuit solenoid).
Even if starting the engine in the fail-safe mode, the gear position remain in the same position.
SHIFT SOLENOID SL1
MALFUNCTIONING
NORMAL
Solenoid Valve
Gear
Solenoid Valve
SL1
SL2
S4
ON
ON
OFF
1st
X
ON
OFF
2nd
OFF
ON
OFF
2nd
X
ON
OFF
2nd
OFF
X
OFF
OFF
OFF OFF
3rd
X
3rd
OFF
X
3rd
OFF
X
SL1 SL2
S4
Gear
SHIFT SOLENOID SL2
MALFUNCTIONING
Solenoid Valve
Gear
SL1 SL2 S4
ON
X
OFF
3rd
OFF
OFF
OFF
ON
O/D
X
ON
ON
ON
SHIFT SOLENOID SL1
AND SL2
MALFUNCTIONING
Solenoid Valve
Gear
SL1 SL2 S4
SHIFT SOLENOID SL1
AND S4
MALFUNCTIONING
Solenoid Valve
Gear
SL1 SL2 S4
X
1st
3rd
OFF
ON
X
2nd
OFF
3rd
OFF OFF
X
3rd
ON
O/D
OFF OFF
X
3rd
SHIFT SOLENOID SL2
AND S4
MALFUNCTIONING
Solenoid Valve
Gear
SL1 SL2
S4
ON
X
3rd
X
OFF
X
OFF
3rd
X
ON
X
2nd
X
X
OFF
3rd
X
ON
X
2nd
OFF
X
X
X
X
OFF
3rd
X
X
2nd
OFF
X
X
2nd
OFF
X
ON
OFF
X
X
ON
O/D
X
Gear
ON
X
OFF
Solenoid Valve
SL1 SL2 S4
ON
OFF OFF
ON
OFF
SHIFT SOLENOID S4
MALFUNCTIONING
SHIFT SOLENOID SL1,
SL2 AND S4
MALFUNCTIONING
Solenoid Valve
Gear
SL1 SL2 S4
X
X
X
3rd
3rd
X
X
X
3rd
X
3rd
X
X
X
3rd
X
3rd
X
X
X
3rd
ON
: Condition in the normal operation is shown on the up of ” ”.
Condition in the fail-safe mode is shown on the down of ” ”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1107
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-891
05F2X-05
HYDRAULIC TEST
1.
PERFORM HYDRAULIC TEST
(a) Measure the line pressure.
NOTICE:
Perform the test at the normal operating ATF (Automatic Transmission Fluid) temperature 50
to 80°C (122 to 176°F).
The line pressure test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe
the conditions of wheels or wheel stopper outside the vehicle while the other is doing the test.
Be careful to prevent SST’s hose from interfering with the exhaust pipe.
(1)
(2)
SST
SST
C81121
D25472
Warm up the ATF.
Remove the test plug on the front side of the transaxle case and connect SST.
SST 09992-00095 (09992- 00231, 09992-00271)
(3) Fully apply the parking brake and chock the 4
wheels.
(4) Connect an OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to
the DLC3.
(5) Start the engine and check idling speed.
(6) Keep your left foot pressing firmly on the brake pedal and shift into D position.
(7) Measure the line pressure when the engine is idling.
(8) Depress the accelerator pedal all the way down.
Quickly read the highest line pressure when engine
speed reaches stall speed.
(9) In the same way, do the test in R position.
Specified line pressure:
Condition
D position
kPa (kgf / cm2, psi)
R position
kPa (kgf / cm2, psi)
Idling
372 to 412 kPa
(3.8 to 4.2 kgf/cm2, 54 to 60 psi)
672 to 742 kPa
(6.9 to 7.6 kgf/cm2, 97 to 108 psi)
Stall test
931 to 1,031 kPa
(9.5 to 10.5 kgf/cm2, 135 to 150 psi)
1,768 to 1,968 kPa
(18.0 to 20.0 kgf/cm2, 256 to 285 psi)
Evaluation:
Problem
Possible cause
If the measured values at all positions are higher
Line pressure control solenoid (SLT) defective
Regulator valve detective
If the measured values at all positions are lower
Line pressure control solenoid (SLT) defective
Regulator valve detective
Oil pump defective
U/D (Underdrive) direct clutch defective
If pressure is low in the D position only
D position circuit fluid leak
Forward clutch defective
If pressure is low in the R position only
R position circuit fluid leak
Direct clutch defective
1st and reverse brake defective
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1081
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-893
05F2Z-05
INITIALIZATION
1.
RESET MEMORY
CAUTION:
Perform the RESET MEMORY (AT initialization) when replacing the automatic transaxle assy, engine
assy or ECM.
NOTICE:
Hand-held tester only
HINT:
The ECM memorizes the condition that the ECT controls the automatic transaxle assy and engine assy according to those characteristics. Therefore, when the automatic transaxle assy, engine assy, or ECM has
been replaced, it is necessary to reset the memory so that the ECM can memorize the new information.
Reset procedure is as follows.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the hand-held tester main switch on.
(d) Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II”.
(e) Perform the reset memory procedure from the ENGINE menu.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1083
05-894
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
CAUTION:
After performing the RESET MEMORY, be sure to perform the ROAD TEST (see page 05-887 ) described earlier.
HINT:
The ECM is learned by performing the ROAD TEST.
Tester menu flow:
G23367
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1084
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-895
05ITI-02
LIST OF DISABLE A MONITOR
HINT:
This table indicates ECM monitoring status for the items in the upper columns if the DTCs in each line on
the left are being set.
As for the ”X” mark, when the DTC on the left is stored, detection of the DTC in the upper column is not performed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1085
05-896
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
A98648
A92385
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1086
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-897
A92386
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1087
05-898
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
A98729
A92387
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1088
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-899
A92388
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1089
05-900
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
A92389
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1090
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-901
A92390
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1091
05-902
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05F3E-05
MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
1.
(a)
MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN FOR ECT TEST
Perform this drive pattern as one method to simulate the detection conditions of the ECT malfunctions.
(The DTCs may not be detected due the actual driving conditions. And some codes may not be detected through this drive pattern).
HINT:
Preparation for driving
Warm up the engine sufficiently. (Engine coolant temperature is 60 °C (140 °F) or higher)
Drive the vehicle when the atmospheric temperature is -10 °C (14 °F) or higher. (Malfunction is not
detected when the atmospheric temperature is -10 °C (14 °F) or less)
Driving note
Drive the vehicle through all gears.
Stop → 1st → 2nd → 3rd → O/D → O/D (lock-up ON).
Repeat the above driving pattern three times or more.
NOTICE:
The monitor status can be checked using the OBD II scan tool. When using the hand-held tester, monitor status can be found in the ”ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST” or under ”CARB OBD
II”.
In the event that the drive pattern must be interrupted (possibly due to traffic conditions or other
factors) the drive pattern can be resumed and, in most cases, the monitor can be completed.
CAUTION:
Perform this drive pattern on a level road as much as possible and strictly observe the posted speed
limits and traffic laws while driving.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1092
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-903
Vehicle Speed
Maintain a constant speed or gradual acceleration (with the throttle open)
for 3 minutes or more.*1
Lock-up ON
Vehicle Speed
Approx.100 km/h
(62 mph)
Approx. 80 km/h
(50 mph)
0
Warmed up
sufficiently
Stop
(Idling)
Normal acceleration
through all the gears from 1st to 4th(O/D)
G31593
HINT:
*1: Drive at such a speed in the uppermost gear, to engage lock-up. The vehicle can be driven at a speed
lower than that in the above diagram under the lock-up condition.
NOTICE:
It is necessary to drive the vehicle for approximately 30 minutes to detect DTC P0711 (ATF temperature sensor malfunction).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1093
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-889
05F2W-05
MECHANICAL SYSTEM TESTS
1.
(a)
PERFORM MECHANICAL SYSTEM TESTS
Measure the stall speed.
The object of this test is to check the overall performance of the transaxle and engine by measuring
the stall speeds in the D and R positions.
NOTICE:
Perform the test at the normal operating ATF (Automatic Transmission Fluid) temperature 50
to 80°C (122 to 176°F).
Do not continuously run this test for longer than 10 seconds.
To ensure safety, do this test in a wide, clear level area which provides good traction.
The stall test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe the conditions of wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while the other is doing the test.
(1) Chock the 4 wheels.
(2) Connect an OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(3) Fully apply the parking brake.
(4) Keep your left foot pressed firmly on the brake pedal.
(5) Start the engine.
(6) Shift into the D position. Press all the way down on the accelerator pedal with your right foot.
(7) Quickly read the stall speed at this time.
Stall speed: 2,250 150 rpm
(8) Do the same test in the R position.
Stall speed: 2,250 150 rpm
Evaluation:
Problem
Possible cause
(a) Stall engine speed is low in D and R positions
Engine power output may be insufficient
Stator one-way clutch not operating properly
HINT: If the value is less than the specified value by 600 rpm or
more, the torque converter could be faulty.
(b) Stall engine speed is high in D position
Line pressure is too low
Forward clutch slipping
No. 2 one-way clutch not operating properly
U/D (Underdrive) clutch slipping
(c) Stall engine speed is high in R position
Line pressure is too low
Direct clutch slipping
1st and reverse brake slipping
U/D (Underdrive) clutch slipping
(d) Stall engine speed is high in D and R positions
Line pressure is too low
Improper fluid level
U/D (Underdrive) one-way clutch not operating properly
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1079
05-890
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
(b)
Measure the time lag.
(1) When the shift lever is shifted while the engine is idling, there will be a certain time lapse or lag
before the shock can be felt. This is used for checking the condition of the direct clutch, forward
clutch, and 1st and reverse brake.
NOTICE:
Perform the test at the normal operating ATF temperature 50 to 80 °C (122 to 176 °F).
Be sure to allow 1 minute interval between tests.
Perform the test three times, and measure the time lags. Calculate the average value of the three
time lags.
(2) Connect an OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(3) Fully apply the parking brake.
(4) Start and warm up the engine and check idle speed.
Idle speed: approx. 700 rpm (In N position and A/C OFF)
(5) Shift the lever from N to D position. Using a stop watch, measure the time from when the lever
is shifted until the shock is felt.
Time lag: N → D less than 1.2 seconds
(6) In the same way, measure the time lag for N → R.
Time lag: N → R less than 1.5 seconds
Evaluation (If N → D or N → R time lag is longer than the specified):
Problem
Possible cause
N → D time lag is longer
Line pressure is too low
Forward clutch worn
U/D (Underdrive) one-way clutch not operating
N → R time lag is longer
Line pressure is too low
Direct clutch worn
1st and reverse brake worn
U/D (Underdrive) one-way clutch not operating properly
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1080
05-892
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05F2Y-05
MANUAL SHIFTING TEST
1.
PERFORM MANUAL SHIFTING TEST
HINT:
By this test, it can be determined whether the trouble is within
the electrical circuit or is a mechanical problem in the transaxle.
(a)
(b)
D09299
Disconnect the transmission wire connector.
Inspect the manual driving operation.
Check that the shift and gear positions correspond to the
table below.
While driving, shift through the L, 2 and D positions.
Check that the gear change corresponds to the shift position.
Shift Position
Gear Position
D
3rd
2
3rd
L
3rd
R
Reverse
P
Pawl Lock
HINT:
If the gear positions of the L, 2 and D are difficult to distinguish,
do the following road test (see page 05-887 ).
If any abnormality is found in the above test, the problem is in
the transaxle itself.
(c) Connect the transmission wire connector.
(d) Clear the DTC (see page 05-912 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1082
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-981
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05ITQ-02
O/D MAIN SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The O/D main switch (transmission control switch) is a momentary type switch. When pressing the O/D main
switch, the O/D OFF indicator light lights up and the ECM prohibits shifting into O/D, and when pressing it
once again, the O/D OFF indicator light goes off and the ECM allows shifting into O/D. Turning the IG switch
OFF will reset the O/D OFF indicator light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center J/B
W-B
13
3F
T16
Transmission Control SW and
Transmission Shift Main SW
2
8
L
3H
IF3
W-B 6
2
ECM
GR
16
E5
ODMS
IB
G30835
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1171
05-982
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH-BODY
GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side:
(Connector Front View)
Disconnect the transmission control switch connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
T16
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
6 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
G23398
OK
2
INSPECT TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH
(a)
Switch Side:
(Connector Front View):
T16
G28380
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Press continuously transmission control switch
2-6
Below 1 Ω
Release transmission
control switch
↑
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH
(SEE PAGE 40-61 )
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH-ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
ODMS
G25190
Connect the transmission control switch connector.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Press continuously transmission control switch
E5 - 16 (ODMS) Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Release transmission
control switch
↑
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-904 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1172
05-922
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0705
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05ITL-02
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR CIRCUIT
MALFUNCTION (PRNDL INPUT)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch detects the shift lever position and sends signals to the ECM.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
(A) Any 2 or more signals of the following are ON simultaneously (2-trip detection logic)
NSW input signal is ON.
R input signal is ON.
D input signal is ON.
2 input signal is ON.
L input signal is ON.
(B) Any 2 or more signals of the following are ON simultaneously (2-trip detection logic)
P input signal is ON.
R input signal is ON.
N input signal is ON.
D input signal is ON.
2 input signal is ON.
L input signal is ON.
P0705
Open or short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0705: Park/neutral position switch/Verify switch input
Park/neutral position switch
Continuous
2 sec.
2 driving cycles
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Condition (A) and (B)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-895
Ignition switch
ON
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1112
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-923
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met: Condition (A) or (B)
Condition (A)
Number of the following signal input at the same time
2 or more
NSW switch
ON
R switch
ON
D switch
ON
2 switch
ON
L switch
ON
Condition (B)
Number of the following signal input at the same time
2 or more
P switch
ON
R switch
ON
N switch
ON
D switch
ON
2 switch
ON
L switch
ON
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Park/neutral position switch
The park/neutral position switch sends only one signal to the ECM.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1113
05-924
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
17
STA
E7
B
4
EB2
B
To
STARTER Relay
L-W
P1
Park/Neutral Position SW
5 P
N 4
NSW
8
L
E6
Y-G
7
IM1
R
G
18
IM1
P
9
2
E6
L-W
8
IM1
Y
10
D
E6
LL 8
2L 3
DL 7
2 RB
Passenger Side J/B
20
IM1
R-B
RL 1
L
6
4A
5
4K
9
IM1
L-Y
PL 6
V
NL 9
R
F7
FL Block
W
1
FL MAIN
B
ALT
2
E6
J6
J/C
GR
C
C
2
1G
IG1
1
1A
AM1
1
R
6
P
E5
B V
B
Instrument Panel J/B
10
IM1
11
L
J6
J/C
19
IM1
Y-R
R
+B
16
E7
B-R
7
N
E5
GR
I15
Ignition SW
7
1C
G
6
1C
4 IG1
AM1 2
W
2
Battery
G30838
G32478
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1114
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-925
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Push the ”ON” button of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
(e) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST”.
(f)
According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Item
Measurement Item/
Range (display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
When the shift lever position displayed on the hand-held tester differs from the actual position, adjustment of the PNP switch or the
shift cable may be incorrect.
PNP SW [NSW]
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
P or N: ON
Except P or N: OFF
LOW
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
L: ON
Except L: OFF
↑
2ND
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
2: ON
Except 2: OFF
↑
REVERSE
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
R: ON
Except R: OFF
↑
4TH/DRIVE
PNP SW Status/
ON or OFF
Shift lever position is;
D: ON
Except D: OFF
↑
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1115
05-926
1
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY
(a)
(b)
Switch Side:
(Connector Front View):
Disconnect the park/neutral position switch connector.
Measure resistance according to the value(s) in the table
below when the shift lever is moved to each position.
Standard:
Shift Position
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P
2 - 6 and 4 - 5
Below 1 Ω
Except P
↑
10 kΩ or higher
R
2-1
Below 1 Ω
Except R
↑
10 kΩ or higher
N
2 - 9 and 4 - 5
Below 1 Ω
Except N
↑
10 kΩ or higher
D
2-7
Below 1 Ω
Except D
↑
10 kΩ or higher
2
2-3
Below 1 Ω
Except 2
↑
10 kΩ or higher
L
2-8
Below 1 Ω
Except L
↑
10 kΩ or higher
P1
G26080
NG
REPLACE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-3 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1116
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-927
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ECM)
NSW(+)
L(+)
D(+)
N(+)
R(+) 2(+)
P(+)
E7
E9
ON
E8
ECM:
E6
(a)
(b)
Connect the transmission control switch connector of shift
lock control unit assy.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, and measure
the voltage according to the value(s) in the table below
when the shift lever is moved to each position.
E5
G26425
Standard:
Shift Position
Tester Connection
Specified condition
P and N
E7 - 16 (NSW) - Body ground
Below 1 V
Except P and N
↑
10 to 14 V
P
E5 - 6 (P) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Except P
↑
Below 1 V
N
E5 - 7 (N) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Except N
↑
Below 1 V
R
E6 - 11 (R) - Body ground
10 to 14 V*
Except R
↑
Below 1 V
D
E6 - 10 (D) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Except D
↑
Below 1 V
2
E6 - 9 (2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Except 2
↑
Below 1 V
L
E6 - 8 (L) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Except L
↑
Below 1 V
HINT:
*: The voltage will drop slightly due to lighting up of the back up
light.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1117
05-928
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
DTC
P0710
TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE
SENSOR ”A” CIRCUIT
DTC
P0712
TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE
SENSOR ”A” CIRCUIT LOW INPUT
DTC
P0713
TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE
SENSOR ”A” CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
0527N-31
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ATF (Automatic Transmission Fluid) temperature sensor converts the fluid temperature into a resistance
value which is input into the ECM.
The ECM applies a voltage to the temperature sensor through ECM terminal THO1 (THO).
The sensor resistance changes with the transmission fluid temperature. As the temperature becomes higher, the sensor resistance decreases.
One terminal of the sensor is grounded so that the sensor resistance decreases and the voltage goes down
as the temperature becomes higher.
The ECM calculates the fluid temperature based on the voltage signal.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0710
(a) and (b) is detected momentary within 0.5 sec. when neither
P0712 or P0713 is not detected (1-trip detection logic)
(a) ATF temperature sensor resistance is less than 79 Ω.
(b) ATF temperature sensor resistance is more than 156 kΩ.
HINT:
Within 0.5 sec., the malfunction switches from (a) to (b) or from
(b) to (a)
Open or short in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
P0712
ATF temperature sensor resistance is less than 79 Ω for 0.5
sec. or more (1-trip detection logic)
Short in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
P0713
ATF temperature sensor resistance is more than 156 kΩ when
15 minutes or more after the engine start
DTC is detected for 0.5 sec. or more (1-trip detection logic)
Open in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The automatic transmission fluid (ATF) temperature sensor converts ATF temperature to an electrical resistance value. Based on the resistance, the ECM determines the ATF temperature, and the ECM detects an
opens or shorts in the ATF temperature circuit. If the resistance value of the ATF temperature is less than
79 Ω*1 or more than 156 kΩ*2, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the ATF sensor or wiring. The ECM will
turn on the MIL and store the DTC.
*1: 150C (302F) or more is indicated regardless of the actual ATF temperature.
*2: -40C (-40F) is indicated regardless of the actual ATF temperature.
HINT:
The ATF temperature can be checked on the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester display.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1118
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-929
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0710: ATF temperature sensor/Range check (Fluttering)
P0712: ATF temperature sensor/Range check (Low resistance)
P0713: ATF temperature sensor/Range check (High resistance)
ATF temperature sensor (TFT sensor)
Continuous
0.5 sec.
Immediate
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P0710: Range check (Fluttering)
P0712: Range check (Low resistance)
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present.
See page 05-895
The typical enabling condition is not available.
-
P0713: Range check (High resistance)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-895
Time after engine start
15 min. or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0710: Range check (Fluttering)
Less than 79 Ω
or
More than 156 kΩ
TFT (transmission fluid temperature) sensor
P0712: Range check (Low resistance)
Less than 79 Ω
TFT (transmission fluid temperature) sensor
P0713: Range check (High resistance)
TFT (transmission fluid temperature) sensor
More than 156 kΩ
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
TFT (transmission fluid temperature)
Atmospheric temperature - approx. 130C (266F)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1119
05-930
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
E10
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
ECM
O
BR
E2
O
6
THO 1
Short Connector
5
5
S28
S29
BR
28
E7
E2
5V
32
E8
G-Y
THO
G30836
G32447
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1120
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-931
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Push the ”ON” button of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
(f)
When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST”.
(g) According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Measurement Item/
Range (display)
Item
Normal Condition
ATF Temp. Sensor Value/
min.: -40C (-40F)
AT FLUID TEMP
Approx. 80C (176F) (After Stall Test)
max.: 215C (419F)
HINT:
When DTC P0712 is output and OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester output is 150C (302F), there is a
short circuit.
When DTC P0713 is output and OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester output is -40C (-40F), there is an
open circuit.
Measure the resistance between terminal THO1 (THO) and body ground.
1
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-40 °C (-40°F)
Open circuit
150°C (302°F) or more
Short circuit
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(ATF TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
THO
(a)
(b)
E10
E2
C54864
(c)
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (THO) - 6 (E2)
79 Ω to 156 kΩ
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (THO) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
6 (E2) - Body ground
↑
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE
(SEE PAGE 40-34 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1121
05-932
2
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
THO
ECM:
E2
(d)
G20668
Connect the transmission wire connector to the transaxle.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 32 (THO) - E7 - 28 (E2)
79 Ω to 156 kΩ
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 32 (THO) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E7 - 28 (E2) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1122
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0711
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-933
05F3A-05
TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE
SENSOR ”A” PERFORMANCE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ATF (Automatic Transmission Fluid) temperature sensor converts the fluid temperature into a resistance
value which is input into the ECM.
DTC No.
P0711
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Both (a) and (b) are detected: (2-trip detection logic)
(a) Intake air and engine coolant temperatures are more than
-10°C (14F) at engine start
(b) After normal driving for over 18 min. and 9 km (6 mile) or
more, ATF temp. is less than 10°C (50F)
Open or short in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ATF temperature sensor converts the ATF temperature to an electrical resistance value. Based on the
resistance, the ECM determines the ATF temperature and detects an opens or shorts in the ATF temperature
circuit or a fault of the ATF temperature sensor.
After running the vehicle for a certain period, the ATF temperature should increase. If the ATF temperature
is below 10C (50F) after running the vehicle for a certain period, the ECM interprets this as a fault, and
turns on the MIL.
When the ATF temperature is 110C (230F) or more after 17 minutes of engine cold start, the ECM also
determines this as a fault, turns on the MIL, and stores the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0711: ATF temperature sensor/Rationality check
ATF temperature sensor (TFT sensor)
Continuous
3 sec.
2 driving cycles
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
Time after engine start
See page 05-895
16 min.and 40 sec. or more
ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
-15 C (5F) or more
TFT (transmission fluid temperature) sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
ECT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
IAT (Intake air temperature) sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Time after engine start
18 min. and 20 sec.
Driving distance after engine start
9 km/h (5.6 mph)
IAT (12 sec. after engine start)
-10 C (14F) or more
ECT (12 sec. after engine start)
-10 C (14F) or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TFT (transmission fluid temperature)
Less than 10C (50F)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
TFT (transmission fluid temperature)
Atmospheric temperature - approx. 130C (266F)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1123
05-934
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
E10
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
ECM
O
BR
E2
O
6
THO 1
Short Connector
5
5
S28
S29
BR
28
E7
E2
5V
32
E8
G-Y
THO
G30836
G32447
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1124
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-935
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Push the ”ON” button of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
(f)
When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST”.
(g) According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Measurement Item/
Range (display)
Item
Normal Condition
ATF Temp. Sensor Value/
min.: -40C (-40F)
AT FLUID TEMP
Approx. 80C (176F) (After Stall Test)
max.: 215C (419F)
HINT:
When DTC P0712 is output and OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester output is 150C (302F), there is a
short circuit.
When DTC P0713 is output and OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester output is -40C (-40F), there is an
open circuit.
Measure the resistance between terminal THO1 (THO) and body ground.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-40 °C (-40°F)
Open circuit
150°C (302°F) or more
Short circuit
HINT:
If a circuit related to the ATF temperature sensor becomes open, P0713 is immediately set (in 0.5 second).
When P0713 is set, P0711 cannot be detected.
It is not necessary to inspect the circuit when P0711 is set.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1125
05-936
1
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
CHECK OTHER DTCS OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0711)
(a)
(b)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch ON.
(c) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(d) Read the DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only ”P0711” is output
A
”P0711” and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides ”P0711” is output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-920 )
A
2
CHECK TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
OK:
Automatic transaxle fluid level is correct.
NG
ADD FLUID
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-34 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1126
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0717
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-937
05F3B-05
TURBINE SPEED SENSOR CIRCUIT NO
SIGNAL
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the rotation speed of the input turbine. By comparing the input turbine speed signal (NT)
with the counter gear speed sensor signal (NC), the ECM detects the shift timing of the gears and appropriately controls the engine torque and hydraulic pressure according to various conditions. Thus, providing
smooth gear shift.
DTC No.
P0717
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
ECM detects conditions (a), (b) and (c) continuity for 5 sec. or
more: (1-trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 mph) or more
(b) Park/neutral position switch (NSW, R and L) is OFF
(c) Speed sensor (NT): less than 300 rpm
5 V/DIV
GND
Open or short in transmission revolution sensor NT (speed
sensor NT) circuit
Transmission revolution sensor NT (speed sensor NT)
ECM
Automatic transaxle assembly
Reference (Using an oscilloscope):
Check the waveform between the terminals NT+ and NTof the ECM connector.
Standard: Refer to the illustration.
Terminal
NT+ - NT-
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 0.5ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph)
0.5 ms/DIV
C53419
C42920
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The NT terminal of the ECM detects a revolution signal from the speed sensor (NT) (input RPM). The ECM
calculates a gearshift comparing the speed sensor (NT) with the speed sensor (NC).
While the vehicle is operating in 2nd, 3rd or O/D gear in the shift position of D, if the input shaft revolution
is less than 300 rpm*1 although the output shaft revolution is more than 1,000 rpm*2, the ECM detects the
trouble, illuminates the MIL and stores the DTC.
*1: Pulse is not output or is irregularly output.
*2: The vehicle speed is 50 km/h (31 mph) or more.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0717: Speed sensor (NT)/Verify pulse input
Speed sensor (NT), Speed sensor (NC)
Continuous
5 sec.
Immediate
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1127
05-938
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-895
Shift change
Shift change is completed and before starting next shift change operation
ECM selected gear
2nd, 3rd or 4th
Output shaft rpm
1,000 rpm or more
NSW switch
OFF
R switch
OFF
L switch
OFF
Engine
Running
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Sensor signal rpm
Less than 300 rpm
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Speed sensor (NT)
Turbine speed is equal to engine speed when lock-up ON
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
T3
Turbine Speed Sensor
27
E8
W
1
2
NT+
5V
35
E8
R-W
NTE1
G31763
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
(a)
OK
NG
Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
The installation bolt is tightened properly and there is
no clearance between the sensor and transaxle case.
NG
REPLACE SPEED SENSOR(NT)
BR3795
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1128
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
05-939
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR(NT)
(a)
Sensor Side:
(Connector Front View):
(b)
T3
2
Disconnect the speed sensor connector from the transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
TOYOTA made:
1
C58536
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
1-2
500 to 620 Ω
Standard:
AISIN made:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
1-2
560 to 680 Ω
REPLACE SPEED SENSOR(NT)
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SPEED SENSOR - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
NT+
Connect the speed sensor connector.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
TOYOTA made:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
E8 - 27 (NT+) - E8 - 35 (NT-)
500 to 620 Ω
NTECM:
C82158
C91565
Standard:
AISIN made:
(d)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
E8 - 27 (NT+) - E8 - 35 (NT-)
560 to 680 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 27 (NT+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E8 - 35 (NT-) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1129
05-940
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0724
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05F3C-05
BRAKE SWITCH ”B” CIRCUIT HIGH
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The purpose of this circuit is to prevent the engine from stalling while driving in lock-up condition, when
brakes are suddenly applied.
When the brake pedal is depressed, this switch sends a signals to the ECM. Then the ECM cancels the operation of the lock-up clutch while braking is in progress.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
The stop light switch remains ON even when the vehicle is
driven in a GO (30 km/h) and STOP (3 km/h) fashion 5 times.
(2-trip detection logic).
P0724
Short in stop light switch signal circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
This DTC indicates that the stop light switch remains on. When the stop light switch remains ON during ”stop
and go” driving, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the stop light switch and the MIL comes on and the ECM
stores the DTC. The vehicle must stop (less than 3 km/h (2 mph)) and go (30 km/h (19 mph) or more) 5 times
for two driving cycles in order to detect malfunction.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0724: Stop light switch/Range check/Rationality
Stop light switch, Vehicle speed sensor
Continuous
GO and STOP 5 times
2 driving cycles
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-895
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
GO (Vehicle speed is 30 km/h (18.63 mph) or more)
Once
STOP (Vehicle speed is less than 3 km/h (1.86 mph))
Once
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Brake switch
Remain ON during GO and STOP 5 times
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1130
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-941
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
3
4L
B
1
2
ECM
Passenger Side J/B
S15
Stop Light SW
Y
12
4M
BR
19 STP
E6
Instrument Panel J/B
1
1E
STOP
1
1A
F7
FL Block
W
B
1
ALT
2
FL MAIN
Battery
G30837
G32448
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1131
05-942
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Push the ”ON” button of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
(e) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST”.
(f)
According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
1
Item
Measurement Item/
Range (display)
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light SW Status/
ON or OFF
Normal Condition
Brake Pedal is depressed: ON
Brake Pedal is released: OFF
INSPECT STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
2
4
1
3
Free Pushed in
E65594
(a)
(b)
Remove the stop lamp switch assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Switch position
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Switch pin free
1-2
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
↑
Below 1 Ω
Switch pin free
3-4
Below 1 Ω
Switch pin pushed in
↑
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1132
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
05-943
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY - ECM)
ECM:
E7
(a)
(b)
STP(+)
E8
E9
E6
E5
G26289
Connect the stop lamp switch assy connector.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below when the brake pedal is depressed and released.
Standard:
Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Brake pedal is depressed
E6 - 19 (STP) Body ground
10 to 14 V
Brake pedal is released
↑
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1133
05-944
DTC
DIAGNOSTICS
P0741
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05F3F-05
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID
PERFORMANCE (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
DSL)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the signals from the throttle position sensor, Air-flow meter, turbine (input) speed sensor,
intermediate (counter) shaft speed sensor and crankshaft position sensor to monitor the engagement condition of the lock-up clutch.
Then the ECM compares the engagement condition of the lock-up clutch with the lock-up schedule in the
ECM memory to detect a mechanical problems of the shift solenoid valve DSL, valve body and torque converter clutch.
DTC No.
P0741
DTC Detection Condition
Lock-up does not occur when driving in lock-up range (normal
driving at 85 km/h [53 mph]), or lock-up remains ON in lockup OFF range (2-trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Shift solenoid valve DSL remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve DSL
Torque converter clutch
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
Line pressure is too low
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Torque converter lock-up is controlled by the ECM based on speed sensor (NT), speed sensor (NC), engine
rpm, engine load, engine temperature, vehicle speed, transmission temperature, and gear selection. The
ECM determines the lock-up status of the torque converter by comparing the engine rpm (NE) to the input
turbine rpm (NT). The ECM calculates the actual transmission gear by comparing input turbine rpm (NT) to
counter gear rpm (NC). When conditions are appropriate, the ECM requests ”lock-up” by applying control
voltage to shift solenoid DSL. When the DSL is turned on, solenoid DSL applies pressure to the lock-up relay
valve and locks the torque converter clutch.
If the ECM detects no lock-up after lock-up has been requested or if it detects lock-up when it is not requested, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the shift solenoid valve DSL or lock-up system performance.
The ECM will turn on the MIL and store the DTC.
Example:
When any of the following is met, the system judges it as a malfunction.
(a) There is a difference in rotation between before and after torque converters even when the ECM commands lock-up.
(Engine speed is at least 75 rpm greater than input turbine speed.)
(b) There is no difference in rotation between before and after torque converters even when the ECM commands lock-up off.
(The difference between engine speed and input turbine speed is less than 35 rpm.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1134
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-945
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
P0741:
Shift solenoid valve DSL/OFF malfunction
Shift solenoid valve DSL/ON malfunction
Shift solenoid valve DSL, Speed sensor (NT), Speed sensor (NC),Crankshaft position sensor (NE), Throttle position sensor (VPA1), Mass air flow sensor (MAF),
Transmission temperature sensor (THO1), Engine coolant temperature sensor
(ECT)
Continuous
Duration
OFF malfunction
3.5 sec.
ON malfunction
1.8 sec.
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ALL:
Transmission range
”D”
ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
60°C (140°F) or more
TFT (Transmission fluid temperature)
-20 C (-4F) or more
TFT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
ECT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Turbine speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Intermediate shaft speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Output speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Electronic throttle system
Not circuit malfunction
OFF malfunction
ECM lock-up command
ON
ECM selected gear
Vehicle speed
3rd or 4th
25 km/h (15.5 mph) or more
ON malfunction
ECM lock-up command
OFF
ECM selected gear
3rd or 4th
Throttle valve opening angle
Vehicle speed
8% or more
25 to 60 km/h (15.5 to 37.2 mph)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met: OFF malfunction or ON malfunction
OFF malfunction
Engine speed - Input (turbine) speed
100 rpm or more
ON malfunction
2 detections are necessary per driving cycle:
1st detection; temporary flag ON
2nd detection; pending fault code ON
Vehicle speed must be under 10 km/h (6.2 mph) once before 2nd detection
Diffierence between engine speed and input (turbine) speed
Less than 35 rpm
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1135
05-946
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method
to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Push the ”ON” button of the hand-held tester.
(f)
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/ACTIVE TEST”.
(g) According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
Item
LOCK UP
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
[Test Details]
Control the shift solenoid DSL to set the automatic transaxle to the
lock-up condition.
[Vehicle Condition]
Vehicle Speed: 58 km/h (36 mph) or more
Possible to check the DSL operation.
HINT:
(h)
HINT:
This test can be conducted when the vehicle speed is 58 km/h (36 mph) or more.
This test can be conducted with the 3rd or O/D gear.
Lightly depress the accelerator pedal and check that the engine speed does not change abruptly.
When changing the accelerator pedal opening angle while driving, if the engine speed does not
change, lock-up is on.
Slowly release, but not fully, the accelerator pedal in order to decelerate. (Fully releasing the pedal will
close the throttle valve and lock-up may be turned off.)
Accelerator Pedal
Opening Angle
Accelerator Pedal
Fully Released
Lock-up OFF
Engine Speed
Lock-up ON
G23400
→ time
G29214
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1136
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-947
CHECK OTHER DTCS OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0741)
(a)
(b)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch ON.
(c) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(d) Read the DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only ”P0741” is output
A
”P0741” and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides ”P0741” is output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
NG
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-920 )
A
2
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(DSL)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
(a)
DSL
(b)
E10
C54864
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
3 - Body ground
11 to 13 Ω
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
ECM:
C82158
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
DSL
C91565
Connect the transmission wire connector.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
E8 - 9 (DSL) - Body ground
11 to 13 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1137
05-948
4
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(DSL)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve DSL:
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve DSL.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
Solenoid Connector (DSL) - Solenoid
Body (DSL)
11 to 13 Ω
(+)
(c)
G28385
Connect positive (+) lead to the terminal of solenoid connector, negative (-) lead to the solenoid body.
OK:
The solenoid valve makes an operating noise.
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(DSL)
OK
5
CHECK TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OK:
The connectors and pins are securely installed.
There is no open or short on the wire harness.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE
(SEE PAGE 40-34 )
OK
6
INSPECT TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY(See chapter 2 in the problem
symptoms table) (SEE PAGE 05-904 )
OK:
There are no foreign objects on each valve and they operate smoothly.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION VALVE
BODY ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-40 )
OK
7
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-29 )
OK:
The torque converter clutch operates normally.
NG
REPLACE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
ASSY
OK
REPAIR AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-12 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1138
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0746
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-949
05C0Z-17
PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID ”A”
PERFORMANCE (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
SL1)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses signals from the vehicle speed sensor to detect the actual gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd or O/D
gear).
Then the ECM compares the actual gear with the shift schedule in the ECM memory to detect mechanical
problems of the shift solenoid valves and valve body.
DTC No.
P0746
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
The gear required by the ECM does not match the actual gear
when driving (2-trip detection logic)
Shift solenoid valve SL1 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve SL1
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. According to the input shaft
revolution, intermediate (counter) shaft revolution and output shaft revolution, the ECM detects the actual
gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd or O/D gear position). When the gear position commanded by the ECM and the
actual gear position are not same, the ECM illuminates the MIL.
Example:
When either condition (a) or (b) is met, the ECM detects a malfunction.
(a) The ECM commands the 1st gear, but the actual gear is 2nd.
(b) The ECM commands the 2nd gear, but the actual gear is 1st.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0746:
Shift solenoid valve SL1/OFF malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1/ON malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1, Speed sensor (NT), Speed sensor (NC), Crankshaft position sensor (NE)
Continuous
OFF malfunction, ON malfunction (A)
0.8 sec.
ON malfunction (B)
1 sec.
2 driving cycles
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1139
05-950
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ALL:
Transmission range
”D”
ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
60°C (140°F) or more
TFT (Transmission fluid temperature)
-20 C (-4F) or more
TFT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
ECT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Turbine speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Intermediate shaft speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Output speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Electronic throttle system
Not circuit malfunction
OFF malfunction
ECM selected gear
Vehicle speed
Throttle valve opening angle
1st
10 to 40 km/h (6.2 to 24.9 mph)
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
ON malfunction (A)
ECM selected gear
Vehicle speed
Throttle valve opening angle
2nd
10 km/h (6.2 mph) or more
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
ON malfunction (B)
ECM lock-up command
OFF
ECM selected gear
3rd or 4th
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met: OFF malfunction, or ON malfunction (A) and (B)
2 detections are necessary per driving cycle:
1st detection; temporary flag ON
2nd detection; pending fault code ON
OFF malfunction
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
1.49 to 1.63
ON malfunction (A)
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
2.72 to 2.86
ON malfunction (B)
Engine speed - Input (tubine) speed
250 rpm or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1140
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-951
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method
to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Push the ”ON” button of the hand-held tester.
(e) Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/ACTIVE TEST/SHIFT”.
(f)
According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
HINT:
While driving, the shift position can be forcibly changed with the hand-held tester.
Comparing the shift position commanded by the ACTIVE TEST with the actual shift position enables you
to confirm the problem (see page 05-916 ).
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SHIFT
[Test Details]
Operate the shift solenoid valve and set the each shift position by yourself.
[Vehicle Condition]
Less than 50 km/h (31 mph)
[Others]
Press ”→” button: Shift up
Press ”←” button: Shift down
Possible to check the operation of
the shift solenoid valves.
HINT:
This test can be conducted when the vehicle speed is 50 km/h (31 mph) or less.
The shift position commanded by the ECM is shown in the DATA LIST/SHIFT display on the hand-held
tester.
1
CHECK OTHER DTCS OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0746)
(a)
(b)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch ON.
(c) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(d) Read the DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only ”P0746” is output
A
”P0746” and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides ”P0746” is output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-920 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1141
05-952
2
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL1)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve SL1:
1
2
(c)
1
2
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve SL1.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
1-2
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Connect the positive (+) lead with a 21 W bulb to terminal
2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solenoid
valve connector, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
(+)
D25466
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL1)
OK
3
INSPECT TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY(See chapter 2 in the problem
symptoms table) (SEE PAGE 05-904 )
OK:
There are no foreign objects on each valve and they operate smoothly.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION VALVE
BODY ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-40 )
OK
4
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-29 )
OK:
The torque converter clutch operates normally.
NG
REPLACE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-12 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1142
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0748
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-953
05C10-19
PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID ”A”
ELECTRICAL (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
SL1)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Shifting from 1st to O/D is performed in combination with ”ON” and ”OFF” operation of the shift solenoid
valves SL1 and SL2 which is controlled by the ECM. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the shift
solenoid valves, the ECM controls the remaining normal shift solenoid valve to allow the vehicle to be operated smoothly (Fail safe function).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0748
ECM checks for an open or short circuit in shift solenoid valves
SL1 (1-trip detection logic)
Output signal duty equals to 100%
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL1
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. When there is an open or
short circuit in any shift solenoid valve circuit, the ECM detects the problem and illuminates the MIL and
stores the DTC. And the ECM performs the fail-safe function and turns the other shift solenoid valves in good
condition ”ON/OFF” (In case of an open or short circuit, the ECM stops sending current to the circuit.)
(see page 05-916 ).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0748: Shift solenoid valve SL1/Range check
Shift solenoid valve SL1
Continuous
1 sec.
Immediate
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-895
Battery voltage
10 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Output signal duty
100%
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Output signal duty
Less than 100%
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1143
05-954
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
E10 Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
W
19
E8
R-B
5
SL1+
CPU
SL1+
B
18 SL1E8
B-W
SL1-
ECM
+B
10
G31765
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(SL1)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
(a)
E10
(b)
SL1+
SL1D25234
(c)
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
5 (SL1+) - 10 (SL1-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
SL1+ - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
SL1- - Body ground
↑
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1144
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
05-955
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
Connect the transmission connector to the transaxle.
Disconnect the connector from the ECM.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
E8 - 19 (SL1+) - E8 - 18 (SL1-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
ECM:
SL1+
SL1C82158
C91565
(d)
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 19 (SL1+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E8 - 18 (SL1-) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-9 )
3
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL1)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve SL1:
1
2
(c)
1
2
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve SL1.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
1-2
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Connect the positive (+) lead with a 21 W bulb to terminal
2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solenoid
valve connector, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
(+)
D25466
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL1)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-34 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1145
05-956
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0766
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05C11-19
SHIFT SOLENOID ”D” PERFORMANCE
(SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE S4)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses signals from the vehicle speed sensor to detect the actual gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd or O/D
gear).
Then the ECM compares the actual gear with the shift schedule in the ECM memory to detect mechanical
problems of the shift solenoid valves and valve body.
DTC No.
P0766
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
The gear required by the ECM does not match the actual gear
when driving (2-trip detection logic)
Shift solenoid valve S4 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve S4
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. According to the input shaft
revolution, intermediate (counter) shaft revolution and output shaft revolution, the ECM detects the actual
gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd or O/D gear position). When the gear position commanded by the ECM and the
actual gear position are not same, the ECM illuminates the MIL and stores the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0766:
Shift solenoid valve S4/ON malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4/OFF malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4, Speed sensor (NT), Speed sensor (NC), Crankshaft position sensor (NE)
Continuous
1 sec.
2 driving cycles
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Transmission range
”D”
ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
60°C (140°F) or more
TFT (Transmission fluid temperature)
-20 C (-4F) or more
TFT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
ECT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Turbine speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Intermediate shaft speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Output speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Electronic throttle system
Not circuit malfunction
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1146
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-957
OFF malfunction
ECM selected gear
4th
Throttle valve opening angle
Vehicle speed
5% or more
10 km/h (6.2 mph) or more
ON malfunction
ECM selected gear
3rd
Throttle valve opening angle
Vehicle speed
5% or more
10 km/h (6.2 mph) or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met: OFF malfunction or ON malfunction
2 detections are necessary per driving cycle:
1st detection; temporary flag ON
2nd detection; pending fault code ON
OFF malfunction
Intermediate shaft speed/Output speed
1.34 to 1.48
ON malfunction
Intermediate shaft speed/Output speed
0.95 to 1.09
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1147
05-958
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method
to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Push the ”ON” button of the hand-held tester.
(e) Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/ACTIVE TEST/SHIFT”.
(f)
According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
HINT:
While driving, the shift position can be forcibly changed with the hand-held tester.
Comparing the shift position commanded by the ACTIVE TEST with the actual shift position enables you
to confirm the problem (see page 05-916 ).
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SHIFT
[Test Details]
Operate the shift solenoid valve and set the each shift position by yourself.
[Vehicle Condition]
Less than 50 km/h (31 mph)
[Others]
Press ”→” button: Shift up
Press ”←” button: Shift down
Possible to check the operation of
the shift solenoid valves.
HINT:
This test can be conducted when the vehicle speed is 50 km/h (31 mph) or less.
The shift position commanded by the ECM is shown in the DATA LIST/SHIFT display on the hand-held
tester.
1
CHECK OTHER DTCS OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0766)
(a)
(b)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch ON.
(c) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(d) Read the DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only ”P0766” is output
A
”P0766” and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides ”P0766” is output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-920 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1148
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-959
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(S4)
Shift Solenoid Valve S4:
(+)
(-)
G28386
(a)
(b)
Remove the shift solenoid valve S4.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
Solenoid Connector (S4) - Solenoid
Body (S4)
11 to 15 Ω
(c)
Connect positive (+) lead to the terminal of solenoid connector, negative (-) lead to the solenoid body.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(S4)
OK
3
INSPECT TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY(See chapter 2 in the problem
symptoms table) (SEE PAGE 05-904 )
OK:
There are no foreign objects on each valve and they operate smoothly.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION VALVE
BODY ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-40 )
OK
4
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-29 )
OK:
The torque converter clutch operates normally.
NG
REPLACE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-12 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1149
05-960
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0776
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05C13-17
PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID ”B”
PERFORMANCE (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
SL2)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses signals from the vehicle speed sensor to detect the actual gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd or O/D
gear).
Then the ECM compares the actual gear with the shift schedule in the ECM memory to detect mechanical
problems of the shift solenoid valves and valve body.
DTC No.
P0776
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
The gear required by the ECM does not match the actual gear
when driving (2-trip detection logic)
Shift solenoid valve SL2 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve SL2
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. According to the input shaft
revolution, intermediate (counter) shaft revolution and output shaft revolution, the ECM detects the actual
gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd or O/D gear position). When the gear position commanded by the ECM and the
actual gear position are not same, the ECM illuminates the MIL and stores the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0776:
Shift solenoid valve SL2/OFF malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2/ON malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2, Speed sensor (NT), Speed sensor (NC), Crankshaft position sensor (NE)
Continuous
0.8 sec.
2 driving cycles
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Transmission range
”D”
ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
60°C (140°F) or more
TFT (Transmission fluid temperature)
-20 C (-4F) or more
TFT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
ECT sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Turbine speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Intermediate shaft speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Output speed sensor circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Not circuit malfunction
Electronic throttle system
Not circuit malfunction
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1150
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-961
OFF malfunction
ECM selected gear
Vehicle speed
Throttle valve opening angle
1st
10 km/h (6.2 mph) or more
15% or more
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(vary with engine speed)
ON malfunction
ECM selected gear
Vehicle speed
Throttle valve opening angle
3rd or 4th
10 km/h (6.2 mph) or more
4.5% or more at engine speed 1,900 rpm
(Varies with engine speed)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met: OFF malfunction or ON malfunction
2 detections are necessary per driving cycle:
1st detection; temporary flag ON
2nd detection; pending fault code ON
OFF malfunction
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
0.93 to 1.07
ON malfunction
Input (turbine) speed/Intermediate shaft speed
1.49 to 1.63
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1151
05-962
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the hand-held tester allows the relay, VSV, actuator and so on to operate without parts removal. Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of troubleshooting is one method
to shorten labor time.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Turn the ignition switch off.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(d) Push the ”ON” button of the hand-held tester.
(e) Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/ACTIVE TEST/SHIFT”.
(f)
According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
HINT:
While driving, the shift position can be forcibly changed with the hand-held tester.
Comparing the shift position commanded by the ACTIVE TEST with the actual shift position enables you
to confirm the problem (see page 05-916 ).
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SHIFT
[Test Details]
Operate the shift solenoid valve and set the each shift position by yourself.
[Vehicle Condition]
Less than 50 km/h (31 mph)
[Others]
Press ”→” button: Shift up
Press ”←” button: Shift down
Possible to check the operation of
the shift solenoid valves.
HINT:
This test can be conducted when the vehicle speed is 50 km/h (31 mph) or less.
The shift position commanded by the ECM is shown in the DATA LIST/SHIFT display on the hand-held
tester.
1
CHECK OTHER DTCS OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0776)
(a)
(b)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and push the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester main
switch ON.
(c) When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DTC INFO/CURRENT CODES”.
(d) Read the DTCs using the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only ”P0776” is output
A
”P0776” and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides ”P0776” is output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(SEE PAGE 05-920 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1152
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-963
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL2)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve SL2:
1
2
(c)
1
2
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve SL2.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
1-2
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Connect the positive (+) lead with a 21 W bulb to terminal
2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solenoid
valve connector, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
(+)
D25466
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL2)
OK
3
INSPECT TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY(See chapter 2 in the problem
symptoms table) (SEE PAGE 05-904 )
OK:
There are no foreign objects on each valve and they operate smoothly.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION VALVE
BODY ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-40 )
OK
4
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-29 )
OK:
The torque converter clutch operates normally.
NG
REPLACE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
ASSY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-12 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1153
05-964
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0778
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05C14-17
PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID ”B”
ELECTRICAL (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
SL2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Shifting from 1st to O/D is performed in combination with ”ON” and ”OFF” operation of the shift solenoid
valves SL1 and SL2 which is controlled by the ECM. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the shift
solenoid valves, the ECM controls the remaining normal shift solenoid valve to allow the vehicle to be operated smoothly (Fail safe function).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0778
ECM checks for an open or short circuit in shift solenoid valves
SL2 (1-trip detection logic)
Output signal duty equals to 100%
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL2
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. When there is an open or
short circuit in any shift solenoid valve circuit, the ECM detects the problem and illuminates the MIL and
stores the DTC. And the ECM performs the fail-safe function and turns the other shift solenoid valves in good
condition ”ON/OFF” (In case of an open or short circuit, the ECM stops sending current to the circuit.)
(see page 05-916 ).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0778: Shift solenoid valve SL2/Range check
Shift solenoid valve SL2
Continuous
1 sec.
Immediate
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-895
Battery voltage
10 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Output signal duty
100%
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Output signal duty
Less than 100%
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1154
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-965
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
E10 Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
ECM
Y
15
E8
L-Y
SL2+ 4
SL2+
BR
14
SL2E8
L-R
SL2-
9
G31765
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(SL2)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
SL2+
(a)
E10
(b)
SL2D25234
(c)
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
4 (SL2+) - 9 (SL2-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
4 (SL2+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
9 (SL2-) - Body ground
↑
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1155
05-966
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
ECM:
C82158
SL2+
SL2C91565
(d)
Connect the transmission connector to the transaxle.
Disconnect the connector from the ECM.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
E8 - 15 (SL2+) - E8 - 14 (SL2-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 15 (SL2+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E8 - 14 (SL2-) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-9 )
3
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL2)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve SL2:
1
2
(c)
1
2
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve SL2.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
1-2
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Connect the positive (+) lead with a 21 W bulb to terminal
2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solenoid
valve connector, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
(+)
D25466
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SL2)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-34 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1156
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0793
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-967
05F3D-05
INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SPEED SENSOR
”A”
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the rotation speed of the counter gear. By comparing the counter gear speed signal (NC)
with the direct clutch speed sensor signal (NT), the ECM detects the shift timing of the gears and appropriately controls the engine torque and hydraulic pressure according to various conditions. Thus smooth gear shifting is performed.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
ECM detects conditions (a), (b) and (c) continuity for 5 sec. or
more: (1-trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 50 km/h (31 mph) or more
(b) Park/neutral position switch (NSW) is OFF
(c) Speed sensor (NC): less than 300 rpm
P0793
1 V/DIV
GND
Open or short in transmission revolution sensor NC (speed
sensor NC) circuit
Transmission revolution sensor NC (speed sensor NC)
ECM
Reference (Using an oscilloscope):
Check the waveform between the terminals NC+ and
NC- of the ECM connector.
Standard: Refer to the illustration.
Terminal
NC+ - NC-
Tool setting
1V/DIV, 1ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Vehicle speed 30 km/h (19 mph): (3rd gear)
Engine speed 1,400 rpm
1 ms/DIV
C93866
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The NC terminal of ECM detects a revolution signal from the speed sensor (NC) (counter gear rpm). The
ECM calculates a gearshift comparing the speed sensor (NT) with the speed sensor (NC).
While the vehicle is operating in 2nd, 3rd or O/D gear in the shift position of D, if the counter gear revolution
is less than 300 rpm*1 although the output shaft revolution is more than 1,000 rpm*2, the ECM detects the
trouble, illuminates the MIL and stores the DTC.
*1: Pulse is not output or is irregularly output.
*2: The vehicle speed is 50 km/h (31 mph) or more.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P0793: Speed sensor (NC)/Verify pulse input
Speed sensor (NC), Speed sensor (NT), NSW switch
Continuous
5 sec.
Immediate
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-895
Engine
Running
NSW switch
OFF
Output shaft rpm
1,000 rpm or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1157
05-968
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Sensor signal rpm
Less than 300 rpm
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
[HINT]
4th (O/D) when shift lever position is D position (After warming up the engine);
Intermediate shaft speed (NC) becomes close to the engine speed.
Counter gear speed sensor (NC)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
C6
Counter Gear Speed Sensor
26
E8
Y
1
2
NC+
5V
34
E8
W-G
NCE1
G31763
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1158
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-969
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
According to the DATA LIST displayed by the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester, you can read the value
of the switch, sensor, actuator and so on without parts removal. Reading the DATA LIST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten labor time.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch off.
(c) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(e) Push the ”ON” button of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester.
(f)
When you use hand-held tester:
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA LIST”.
(g) According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Measurement Item/
Range (display)
Item
Normal Condition
[HINT]
4th (O/D) when shift lever position is D position
(After warming up the engine);
Intermediate shaft speed (NC) becomes close
to the engine speed.
Counter Gear Speed/
display: 50 r/min
SPD (NC)
HINT:
SPD (NC) is always 0 while driving:
Open or short in the sensor or circuit.
SPD (NC) is always more than 0 and less than 300 rpm while driving the vehicle at 50 km/h (31 mph)
or more:
Sensor trouble, improper installation, or intermittent connection trouble of the circuit.
1
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
(a)
OK
Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
The installation bolt is tightened properly and there is
no clearance between the sensor and transaxle case.
NG
BR3795
NG
REPLACE SPEED SENSOR(NC)
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1159
05-970
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR(NC)
(a)
Sensor Side:
(Connector Front View):
(b)
C6
2
Disconnect the speed sensor connector from the transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
TOYOTA made:
1
C58536
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
1-2
500 to 620 Ω
Standard:
AISIN made:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
1-2
560 to 680 Ω
REPLACE SPEED SENSOR(NC)
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(SPEED SENSOR - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
NC+
NCC82158
Connect the speed sensor connector.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
TOYOTA made:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
E8 - 26 (NC+) - E8 - 34 (NC-)
500 to 620 Ω
ECM:
C91565
Standard:
AISIN made:
(d)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
E8 - 26 (NC+) - E8 - 34 (NC-)
560 to 680 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 26 (NC+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E8 - 34 (NC-) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1160
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-971
05C17-23
DTC
P0982
SHIFT SOLENOID ”D” CONTROL CIRCUIT
LOW (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE S4)
DTC
P0983
SHIFT SOLENOID ”D” CONTROL CIRCUIT
HIGH (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE S4)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Shifting from 1st to O/D is performed in combination with ”ON” and ”OFF” operation of the shift solenoid
valves SL1 and SL2 which is controlled by the ECM. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the shift
solenoid valves, the ECM controls the remaining normal shift solenoid valve to allow the vehicle to be operated smoothly (Fail safe function).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0982
ECM detects short in solenoid valve S4 circuit 2 times when
solenoid valve S4 is operated (1-trip detection logic)
Short in shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Shift solenoid valve S4
ECM
P0983
ECM detects open in solenoid valve S4 circuit 2 times when
solenoid valve S4 is not operated (1-trip detection logic)
Open in shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Shift solenoid valve S4
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM commands gear shifts by turning the shift solenoid valves ”ON/OFF”. When there is an open or
short circuit in any shift solenoid valve circuit, the ECM detects the problem and illuminates the MIL and
stores the DTC. And the ECM performs the fail-safe function and turns the other shift solenoid valves in good
condition ”ON/OFF” (In case of an open or short circuit, the ECM stops sending current to the circuit.)
(see page 05-916 ).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
P0982: Shift solenoid valve S4/Range check (Low resistance)
P0983: Shift solenoid valve S4/Range check (High resistance)
Shift solenoid valve S4
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.064 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P0982: Range check (Low resistance)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-895
Shift solenoid valve S4
ON
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
P0983: Range check (High resistance)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-895
Shift solenoid valve S4
OFF
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1161
05-972
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0982: Range check (Low resistance)
8 Ω or less
Shift solenoid valve S4 resistance
P0983: Range check (High resistance)
Shift solenoid valve S4 resistance
100 kΩ or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Resistance: 11 to 15 Ω at 20C (68F)
Shift solenoid valve S4
WIRING DIAGRAM
E10
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
ECM
+B
11 S4
E8
L
R
S4
8
CPU
G31165
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(S4)
(a)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
(b)
E10
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
8 - Body ground
11 to 15 Ω
S4
D25234
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1162
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-973
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
S4
C82158
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
ECM:
C91565
Connect the transmission connector to the transaxle.
Disconnect the connector from the ECM.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
E8 - 11 (S4) - Body ground
11 to 15 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-9 )
3
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(S4)
Shift Solenoid Valve S4:
(+)
(-)
G28386
(a)
(b)
Remove the shift solenoid valve S4.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
Solenoid Connector (S4) - Solenoid
Body (S4)
11 to 15 Ω
(c)
Connect positive (+) lead to the terminal of solenoid connector, negative (-) lead to the solenoid body.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(S4)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-34 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1163
05-974
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P2716
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05C19-26
PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID ”D”
ELECTRICAL (SHIFT SOLENOID SLT)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Line Pressure
Control Pressure
Current Flow to Solenoid D02290
ON
OFF
The linear solenoid valve (SLT) controls the transmission line
pressure for smooth transmission operation based on signals
from the throttle position sensor and the vehicle speed sensor.
The ECM adjusts the duty cycle of the SLT solenoid valve to
control hydraulic line pressure coming from the primary regulator valve. Appropriate line pressure assures smooth shifting
with varying engine outputs.
(*): Duty Ratio
The duty ratio is the ratio of the period of continuity in one cycle.
For example, if A is the period of continuity in one cycle, and B
is the period of non-continuity, then
Duty Ratio=A/(A+B) x 100 (%)
1 cycle
BE4056
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Condition (a) or (b) below is detected 1 sec. or more:
(1-trip detection logic)
(a) SLT- terminal: 0V
(b) SLT- terminal: 12V
P2716
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SLT circuit
Shift solenoid valve SLT
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
When an open or short in the linear solenoid valve (SLT) circuit is detected, the ECM interprets this as a fault.
The ECM will turn ON the MIL and store the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
Frequency of operation
Duration
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
P2716: Shift solenoid valve SLT/Range check
Shift solenoid valve SLT
Continuous
1 sec.
Immediate
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-895
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Solenoid current cut status
Not cut
CPU commanded duty ratio to SLT
19% or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Solenoid status from IC
Fail (Open or short)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1164
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-975
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Resistance: 5.0 to 5.6 Ω at 20C (68F)
Shift solenoid valve SLT
WIRING DIAGRAM
E10 Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
O
ECM
2
Y-R
SLT+
+B
13
E8
SLT+
7
G
B-Y
SLT-
12
SLT-
E8
G31770
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(SLT)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
(a)
SLT+
(b)
E10
SLTD25234
(c)
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
2 (SLT+) - 7 (SLT-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (SLT+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
7 (SLT-) - Body ground
↑
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1165
05-976
2
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
SLT+
C82158
E8
E9
SLT-
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
ECM:
C91565
(d)
Connect the transmission wire connector to the transaxle.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
E8 - 13 (SLT+) - E8 - 12 (SLT-)
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8 - 13 (SLT+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E8 - 12 (SLT-) - Body ground
↑
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1166
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-977
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SLT)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve SLT:
1
2
(c)
1
2
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve (SLT).
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
1-2
5.0 to 5.6 Ω
Connect the positive (+) lead with a 21 W bulb to terminal
2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solenoid
valve connector, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
The solenoid makes an operating noise.
(+)
D25466
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(SLT)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-34 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1167
05-978
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
0527R-37
DTC
P2769
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID
CIRCUIT LOW (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
DSL)
DTC
P2770
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID
CIRCUIT HIGH (SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
DSL)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The shift solenoid valve DSL is turned ”ON” and ”OFF” by signals from the ECM in order to control the hydraulic pressure operation, the lock-up relay valve, which then the controls operation of the lock-up clutch.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2769
ECM detects short in solenoid valve DSL circuit (0.1 sec.)
when solenoid valve DSL is operated (2-trip detection logic)
Short in shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Shift solenoid valve DSL
ECM
P2770
ECM detects open in solenoid valve DSL circuit (0.1 sec.)
when solenoid valve DSL is not operated (2-trip detection
logic)
Open in shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Shift solenoid valve DSL
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Torque converter lock-up is controlled by the ECM based on engine rpm, engine load, engine temperature,
vehicle speed, transmission temperature, and shift range selection. The ECM determines the lock-up status
of the torque converter by comparing the engine rpm (NE) to the input turbine rpm (NT). The ECM calculates
the actual transmission gear by comparing input turbine rpm (NT) to counter gear rpm (NC). When conditions
are appropriate, the ECM requests ”lock-up” by applying control voltage to shift solenoid DSL. When the
DSL is opened, solenoid DSL applies pressure to the lock-up relay valve and locks the torque converter
clutch. If the ECM detects an open or short in the DSL solenoid circuit, the ECM interprets this as a fault in
the DSL solenoid or circuit. The ECM will turn on the MIL and store the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
Required sensors/Components
P2769: Shift solenoid valve DSL/Range check (Low resistance)
P2770: Shift solenoid valve DSL/Range check (High resistance)
Shift solenoid valve DSL
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.064 sec.
MIL operation
Sequence of operation
2 driving cycles
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P2769: Range check (Low resistance)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-895
Solenoid current cut status
Not cut
Shift solenoid valve DSL
ON
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1168
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-979
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
P2770: Range check (High resistance)
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present.
See page 05-895
Shift solenoid valve DSL
ON
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2769: Range check (Low resistance)
8 Ω or less
Shift solenoid valve DSL resistance
P2770: Range check (High resistance)
Shift solenoid valve DSL resistance
100 kΩ or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Resistance: 11 to 13 Ω at 20C (68F)
Shift solenoid valve DSL
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
E10
Electronically Controlled
Transmission Solenoid
+B
G
3
Y-G
9 DSL
E8
CPU
DSL
G31165
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSMISSION WIRE(DSL)
(a)
Transmission Wire Side:
(Connector Front View):
(b)
E10
Disconnect the transmission wire connector from the
transaxle.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
DSL
D25234
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
3 - Body ground
11 to 13 Ω
Go to step 3
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1169
05-980
2
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TRANSMISSION WIRE - ECM)
E7
E8
E9
E6
(a)
(b)
(c)
E5
Connect the transmission wire connector.
Disconnect the ECM connector.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
E8 - 9 (DSL) - Body ground
11 to 13 Ω
ECM:
DSL
C82158
C91565
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS
CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 01-36 )
OR
OK
REPLACE ECM (SEE PAGE 10-9 )
3
INSPECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(DSL)
(a)
(b)
Shift Solenoid Valve DSL:
(-)
Remove the shift solenoid valve DSL.
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
20 C (68 F)
Solenoid Connector (DSL) - Solenoid
Body (DSL)
11 to 13 Ω
(+)
(c)
G28385
Connect positive (+) lead to the terminal of solenoid connector, negative (-) lead to the solenoid body.
OK:
The solenoid valve makes an operating noise.
NG
REPLACE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE(DSL)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE TRANSMISSION WIRE (SEE PAGE 40-34 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1170
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-887
05F2V-05
ROAD TEST
1.
(a)
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Based on the result of the customer problem analysis, try to reproduce the symptoms. If the problem
is that the transaxle does not shift up, shift down, or the shift point is too high or too low, conduct the
following road test referring to the automatic shift schedule and simulate the problem symptoms.
2.
ROAD TEST
NOTICE:
Perform the test at the ATF (Automatic Transmission Fluid) temperature 50 to 80°C (122 to 176°F) in
the normal operation.
(a) D position test:
Shift into the D position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points.
(1) Check up-shift operation.
Check that 1 → 2, 2 → 3 and 3 → O/D up-shifts take place, and that the shift points conform to
the automatic shift schedule (see page 03-51 ).
HINT:
O/D Gear Up-shift Prohibition Control
Engine coolant temperature is 60 °C (140 °F) or less and vehicle speed is at 70 km/h (43 mph) or less.
ATF temperature is 10 °C (50 °F) or less.
O/D Gear Lock-up Prohibition Control
Brake pedal is depressed.
Accelerator pedal is released.
Engine coolant temperature is 60 °C (140 °F) or less.
(2)
(3)
Check for shift shock and slip.
Check for shock and slip at the 1 → 2, 2 → 3 and 3 → O/D up-shifts.
Check for abnormal noise and vibration.
Check for abnormal noise and vibration when up-shifting from 1 → 2, 2 → 3 and 3 → O/D while
driving with the shift lever in the D position, and check while driving in the lock-up condition.
HINT:
The check for the cause of abnormal noise and vibration must be done thoroughly as it could also be due
to loss of balance in the differential, torque converter clutch, etc.
(4) Check kick-down operation.
Check vehicle speeds when the 2nd to 1st, 3rd to 2nd and O/D to 3rd kick-downs take place
while driving with the shift lever in the D position. Confirm that each speed is within the applicable
vehicle speed range indicated in the automatic shift schedule (see page 03-51 ).
(5) Check abnormal shock and slip at kick-down.
(6) Check the lock-up mechanism.
Drive in D position (O/D gear), at a steady speed (lock-up ON).
Lightly depress the accelerator pedal and check that the engine speed does not change
abruptly.
HINT:
There is no lock-up function in the 1st and 2nd gear.
If there is a big jump in engine speed, there is no lock-up.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1077
05-888
(b)
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
2 position test:
Shift into the 2 position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points.
(1) Check up-shift operation.
Check that the 1 → 2 up-shift takes place and that the shift point conforms to the automatic shift
schedule (see page 03-51 ).
HINT:
There is no 3rd up-shift and lock-up in the 2 position.
(2) Check engine braking.
While running in the 2 position and 2nd gear, release the accelerator pedal and check the engine
braking effect.
(3) Check for abnormal noise during acceleration and deceleration, and for shock at up-shift and
down-shift.
(c)
L position test:
Shift into the L position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points.
(1) Check no up-shift.
While running in the L position, check that there is no up-shift to 2nd gear.
HINT:
There is no lock-up in the L position.
(2) Check engine braking.
While running in the L position, release the accelerator pedal and check the engine braking effect.
(3) Check for abnormal noise during acceleration and deceleration.
(d)
R position test:
Shift into the R position, lightly depress the accelerator pedal, and check that the vehicle moves backward without any abnormal noise or vibration.
CAUTION:
Before conducting this test ensure that the test area is free from people and obstruction.
(e)
P position test:
Stop the vehicle on the grade (more than 5°) and after shifting into the P position, release the parking
brake. Then, check that the parking lock pawl holds the vehicle in place.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1078
05-882
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05F2U-05
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
(a)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECT (Electronic controlled automatic transmission/transaxle) is an automatic transmission/transaxle that electronically controls shift timing using the ECM. The ECM detects electrical signals that indicate engine and driving conditions, controls the shift point, and selects the appropriate shift pattern
based on driver habits and road conditions. As a result, fuel efficiency and power transmission/transaxle performance are improved.
Shift shock has been reduced by controlling the engine and transmission/transaxle simultaneously.
In addition, the ECT has the following features:
Diagnostic function.
Fail-safe function when a malfunction occurs.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1072
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-881
05F2T-05
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
The configuration of the electronic control system in the U241E/U140F automatic transaxles is as shown
in the following chart.
NE
Crankshaft Position Sensor
SL1
Engine Coolant
Temperature Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor
THW
VTA1, 2
VC
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Shift Solenoid Valve SL1
SL2
Shift Solenoid Valve SL2
NSW
R, D, 2, L
Transmission Control Switch
(O/D Main Switch)
ODMS
SLT
Speed Sensor
Shift Solenoid Valve SLT
ECM
S4
Shift Solenoid Valve S4
Skid Control ECU
Combination Meter
SPD
DSL
Counter Gear Speed Sensor
(Speed Sensor NC)
NC
Input Turbine Speed Sensor
(Speed Sensor NT)
NT
Stop Lamp Switch Assy
ATF (Automatic Transmission
Fluid) Temperature Sensor
Shift Solenoid Valve DSL
W
MIL
(Malfunction Indicator Lamp)
SIL
DLC3
(Data Link Connector 3)
STP
THO
TC
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1071
05-878
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05F38-05
PART AND SYSTEM NAME LIST
This reference list indicates the part names used in this manual along with their definitions.
Part and system name
Definition
Toyota HCAC system, Hydrocarbon adsorptive Catalyst
(HCAC) system, HC adsorptive three-way catalyst
HC adsorptive three-way catalytic converter
Variable Valve Timing sensor, VVT sensor
Camshaft position sensor
Variable valve timing system, VVT system
Camshaft timing control system
Camshaft timing oil control valve, Oil control valve OCV,
VVT, VSV
Camshaft timing oil control valve
Variable timing and lift, VVTL
Camshaft timing and lift control
Crankshaft position sensor ”A”
Crankshaft position sensor
Engine speed sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
THA
Intake air temperature
Knock control module
Engine knock control module
Knock sensor
Engine knock sensor
Mass or volume air flow circuit
Mass air flow sensor circuit
Vacuum sensor
Manifold air pressure sensor
Internal control module, Control module, Engine control
ECU, PCM
Power train control module
FC idle
Deceleration fuel cut
Idle air control valve
Idle speed control
VSV for CCV, Canister close valve VSV for canister control
Evaporative emissions canister vent valve
VSV for EVAP, Vacuum switching valve assembly No. 1,
EVAP VAV, Purge VSV
Evaporative emissions canister purge valve
VSV for pressure switching valve, Bypass VSV
Evaporative emission pressure switching valve
Vapor pressure sensor, EVAP pressure sensor, Evaporative
emission control system pressure sensor
Fuel tank pressure sensor
Charcoal canister
Evaporative emissions canister
ORVR system
On-boad refueling vapor recovery system
Intake manifold runner control
Intake manifold tuning system
Intake manifold runner valve, IMRV, IACV (runner valve)
Intake manifold tuning valve
Intake control VSV
Intake manifold tuning solenoid valve
AFS
Air fuel ratio sensor
O2 sensor
Heater oxygen sensor
Oxygen sensor pumping current circuit
Oxygen sensor output signal
Oxygen sensor reference ground circuit
Oxygen sensor signal ground
Accel position sensor
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Throttle actuator control motor, Actuator control motor, Electronic throttle motor, Throttle control motor
Electronic throttle actuator
Electronic throttle control system, Throttle actuator control
system
Electronic throttle control system
Throttle/pedal position sensor, Throttle/pedal position switch,
Throttle position sensor/switch
Throttle position sensor
Turbo press sensor
Turbocharger pressure sensor
Turbo VSV
Turbocharger pressure control solenoid valve
P/S pressure switch
Power-steering pressure switch
VSV for ACM
Active control engine mount
Speed sensor, Vehicle speed sensor ”A”, Speed sensor for
skid control ECU
Vehicle speed sensor
ATF temperature sensor, Trans. fluid temp. sensor, ATF
temperature sensor ”A”
Transmission fluid temperature sensor
Electronic controlled automatic transmission, ECT
Electronically controlled automatic
Intermediate shaft speed sensor ”A”
Counter gear speed sensor
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1068
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
Part and system name
05-879
Definition
Output speed sensor
Output shaft speed sensor
Input speed sensor, Input turbine speed sensor ”A”, Speed
sensor (NT), Turbine speed sensor
Input turbine speed sensor
PNP switch, NSW
Park/neutral position switch
Pressure control solenoid
Transmission pressure control solenoid
Shift solenoid
Transmission shift solenoid valve
Transmission control switch, Shift lock control unit
Shift lock control module
Engine immobilizer system, Immobilizer system
Vehicle anti-theft system
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1069
05-886
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
0527I-43
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
Automatic Transaxle
System Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
:
VIN
Customer’s Name
Production Date
/
/
Licence Plate No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
Date Problem
Occurred
How Often Does
Problem Occur?
/
km
mile
Odometer Reading
/
Continuous
/
Intermittent (
Vehicle does not move ( Any position
No up-shift
( 1st → 2nd
No down-shift
( O/D → 3rd
times a day)
Particular position)
2nd → 3rd
3rd → O/D )
3rd → 2nd
2nd → 1st )
Lock-up malfunction
Symptoms
Shift point too high or too low
Harsh engagement ( N → D
Lock-up
Any drive position)
Slip or shudder
No kick-down
Others
Check Item
MIL
Normal
Remains ON
1st Time
Normal code
Malfunction code (DTC
)
2nd Time
Normal code
Malfunction code (DTC
)
DTC Check
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1076
05-920
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
0527K-48
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a DTC is displayed during the DTC check, check the parts listed in the table below and proceed to the page
given.
HINT:
*1 : ... MIL (Malfunction Indicator Lamp) light up
*2 : ... Mark means ECM memorizes the malfunction code if the ECM detects the DTC detection
condition.
This DTC may be output when the clutch, brake and gear components etc. inside the automatic transaxle are damaged.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL *1
Memory *2
P0500
(05-216 )
Vehicle Speed Sensor ”A”
Combination meter
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor circuit
Vehicle speed sensor
ECM
P0705
(05-922 )
Transmission Range Sensor Circuit Malfunction (PRNDL Input)
Open or short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
P0710
(05-928 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Circuit
Open or short in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
P0711
(05-933 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Performance
Open or short in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
P0712
(05-928 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Circuit Low Input
Short in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
P0713
(05-928 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Circuit High Input
Open in ATF temperature sensor circuit
Transmission wire (ATF temperature sensor)
ECM
Turbine Speed Sensor Circuit No
Signal
Open or short in transmission revolution sensor NT (speed
sensor NT) circuit
Transmission revolution sensor NT (speed sensor NT)
ECM
Automatic transaxle assembly
Brake Switch ”B” Circuit High
Short in stop light switch circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
P0741
(05-944 )
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve DSL)
Shift solenoid valve DSL remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve DSL
Torque converter clutch
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
Line pressure is too low
ECM
P0746
(05-949 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”A”
Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL1)
Shift solenoid valve SL1 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve SL1
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
P0748
(05-953 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”A”
Electrical
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL1)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL1 circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL1
ECM
P0717
(05-937 )
P0724
(05-940 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1110
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-921
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
P0766
(05-956 )
Shift Solenoid ”D” Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve S4)
Shift solenoid valve S4 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve S4
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
P0776
(05-960 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”B”
Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL2)
Shift solenoid valve SL2 remains open or closed
Valve body is blocked
Shift solenoid valve SL2
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
ECM
P0778
(05-964 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”B”
Electrical
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL2)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL2 circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL2
ECM
P0793
(05-967 )
Intermediate Shaft Speed Sensor ”A”
Open or short in transmission revolution sensor NC (speed
sensor NC) circuit
Transmission revolution sensor NC (speed sensor NC)
ECM
P0982
(05-971 )
Shift Solenoid ”D” Control Circuit
Low (Shift Solenoid Valve S4)
Short in shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Shift solenoid valve S4
ECM
P0983
(05-971 )
Shift Solenoid ”D” Control Circuit
High (Shift Solenoid Valve S4)
Open in shift solenoid valve S4 circuit
Shift solenoid valve S4
ECM
P2716
(05-974 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”D”
Electrical
(Shift Solenoid Valve SLT)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SLT circuit
Shift solenoid valve SLT
ECM
P2769
(05-978 )
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Circuit Low
(Shift Solenoid Valve DSL)
Short in shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Shift solenoid valve DSL
ECM
P2770
(05-978 )
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Circuit High
(Shift Solenoid Valve DSL)
Open in shift solenoid valve DSL circuit
Shift solenoid valve DSL
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1111
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-883
0527H-44
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
The ECM of this system is connected to the multiplex communication system. Therefore, before starting troubleshooting, make sure to check that there is no trouble in the multiplex communication system.
The hand-held tester can be used at steps 3, 4, 6, and 9.
1
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
2
Customer Problem Analysis (SEE PAGE 05-886 )
3
Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to DLC3
4
Check and Clear DTC and Freeze Frame Data (SEE PAGE 05-912 )
5
Visual Inspection
6
Setting the Check Mode Diagnosis (SEE PAGE 05-914 )
7
Problem Symptom Confirmation (SEE PAGE 05-887 )
Symptom does not occur: Go to step 8
Symptom occur: Go to step 9
8
Symptom Simulation (SEE PAGE 01-26 )
9
DTC Check (SEE PAGE 05-912 )
DTC is not output: Go to step 10
DTC is output: Go to step 17
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1073
05-884
10
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
Basic Inspection (SEE PAGE 40-2 , 40-6 and 40-71 )
NG
Go to step 19
OK
11
Mechanical System Test (SEE PAGE 05-889 )
NG
Go to step 16
OK
12
Hydraulic Test (SEE PAGE 05-891 )
NG
Go to step 16
OK
13
Manual Shifting Test (SEE PAGE 05-892 )
NG
Go to step 15
OK
14
Problem Symptoms Table Chapter 1 (SEE PAGE 05-904 )
NG
Go to step 18
OK
15
Problem Symptoms Table Chapter 2 (SEE PAGE 05-904 )
16
Part Inspection
Go to step 19
17
DTC Chart (SEE PAGE 05-920 )
18
Circuit Inspection
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1074
DIAGNOSTICS
19
Repair or Replace
20
Confirmation Test
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-885
End
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1075
05-880
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
0527L-44
LOCATION
Combination Meter
MIL (Malfunction Indicator Lamp)
ECM
Transmission Control Switch
(O/D Main Switch)
Pattern Select Switch
(ECT SNOW Switch)
Stop Lamp Switch
Assy
DLC3
(Data Link Connector 3)
Speed Sensor (NT)
Speed Sensor (NC)
Shift Solenoid Valve SLT
Shift Solenoid Valve SL1
Park/neutral Position
Switch Assy
Shift Solenoid Valve S4
Transmission Wire
(ATF Temperature Sensor)
Shift Solenoid Valve SL2
Shift Solenoid Valve DSL
G32075
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1070
05-876
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
[ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05C0T-29
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
Perform the RESET MEMORY (AT initialization) when replacing the automatic transaxle assy, engine
assy or ECM (see page 05-893 ).
HINT:
Initialization can not be completed by only disconnecting the battery terminal.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1066
05-904
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
0527M-47
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
If a normal code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check although the trouble still occurs, check
the electrical circuits for each symptom in the order given in the charts on the following pages and proceed
to the page given for troubleshooting.
The Matrix Chart is divided into 2 chapters.
1.
Chapter 1: Electronic Circuit Matrix Chart
Refer to the table below when the trouble cause is considered to be electrical.
If the instruction ”Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on matrix chart” is given in the flow chart
of each circuit, proceed to the circuit with the next highest number in the table to continue the check.
If the trouble still occurs even though there are no abnormalities in any of the other circuits, check and
replace the ECM.
HINT:
*1: When the circuit on which mark *1 is attached is a malfunction, DTC could be output (see page 05-920 ).
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
No up-shift (1st → 2nd)
ECM
01-36
No up-shift (2nd → 3rd)
ECM
01-36
No up-shift (3rd → O/D)
1. Transmission control switch (O/D OFF) circuit
2. ECM
05-981
01-36
No down-shift (O/D → 3rd)
ECM
01-36
No down-shift (3rd → 2nd)
ECM
01-36
No down-shift (2nd → 1st)
ECM
01-36
No lock-up or No lock-up off
ECM
01-36
Shift point too high or too low
ECM
01-36
Up-shift to O/D from 3rd (While O/D main switch is OFF)
1. Transmission control switch (O/D OFF) circuit
2. ECM
05-981
01-36
Up-shift to O/D from 3rd while engine is cold
1. Engine coolant temp. sensor circuit *1
2. ECM
05-48
01-36
Harsh engagement (N → D)
ECM
01-36
Harsh engagement (Lock-up)
ECM
01-36
Harsh engagement (Any driving position)
ECM
01-36
Poor acceleration
ECM
01-36
Engine stalls when starting off or stopping
ECM
Malfunction in shifting
01-36
1. Park/neutral position switch
2. ECM
circuit *1
05-922
01-36
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1094
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-905
Chapter 2: On-Vehicle Repair and Off-Vehicle Repair
(: U140F AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual Pub. No. RM836U
U241E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual Pub. No. RM840U)
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Vehicle does not move in any forward positions and reverse positions
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Manual valve
Primary regulator valve
Front and rear planetary gear
U/D planetary gear
U/D one-way clutch (F2)
Forward clutch (C1)
U/D brake (B3)
Vehicle does not move in R position
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Front and rear planetary gear unit
U/D planetary gear unit
Direct clutch (C2)
U/D brake (C3)
1st and reverse brake (B2)
No up-shift (1st → 2nd)
1. Valve body assy
2. No. 1 one-way clutch (F1)
3. 2nd brake (B1)
40-40
No up-shift (2nd → 3rd)
1. Valve body assy
2. Direct clutch (C2)
40-40
No up-shift (3rd → O/D)
1. Valve body assy
2. U/D clutch (C3)
No down-shift (O/D → 3rd)
Valve body assy
No down-shift (3rd → 2nd)
Valve body assy
40-40
No down-shift (2nd → 1st)
Valve body assy
40-40
No lock-up or No lock-up off
1. Lock-up relay valve
2. Torque converter clutch
40-29
Harsh engagement (N → D)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
C1 accumulator
Valve body assy
Forward clutch (C1)
U/D one-way clutch (F2)
No. 1 one-way clutch (F1)
40-40
Harsh engagement (N → R)
1. Valve body assy
2. Direct clutch (C2)
3. 1st and reverse brake (B2)
40-40
Harsh engagement (Lock-up)
1. Lock-up relay valve
2. Torque converter clutch
40-29
Harsh engagement (2nd → 3rd)
Valve body assy
40-40
Harsh engagement (3rd → O/D)
Valve body assy
40-40
Harsh engagement (O/D → 3rd)
Valve body assy
40-40
Slip or shudder (Forward position: After warm-up)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Oil strainer
Torque converter clutch
Forward clutch (C1)
Direct clutch (C2)
U/D brake (C3)
No. 1 one-way clutch (F1)
U/D one-way clutch (F2)
40-40
40-29
Slip or shudder (R position)
1. Oil strainer
2. Direct clutch (C2)
3. 1st and reverse brake (B2)
40-40
Slip or shudder (1st)
No. 1 one-way clutch (F1)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1095
05-906
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
Slip or shudder (2nd)
1. U/D one-way clutch (F2)
2. 2nd brake (B1)
Slip or shudder (3rd)
Direct clutch (C2)
Slip or shudder (O/D)
U/D clutch (C3)
No engine braking (1st ∼ 3rd: D position)
U/D brake (B3)
No engine braking (1st: L position)
1st and reverse brake (B2)
No engine braking (2nd: 2 position)
2nd brake (B1)
Poor acceleration (All position)
1. Torque converter clutch
2. U/D planetary gear
Poor acceleration (O/D)
1. U/D clutch (C3)
2. U/D planetary gear
Large shift shock or engine stalls when starting off or stopping
Torque converter clutch
40-29
No kick-down
Valve body assy
40-40
40-29
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1096
DIAGNOSTICS
-
05-907
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05F36-05
TERMINALS OF ECM
1.
ECM
E7
E9
E8
E6
E5
C80654
C91969
HINT:
Each ECM terminal’s standard voltage is shown in the table below.
In the table, first follow the information under ”Condition”. Look under ”Symbols (Terminal No.)” for the terminals to be inspected. The standard voltage between the terminals is shown under ”Specific Condition”.
Use the illustration above as a reference for the ECM terminals.
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
P (E5-6) - E1 (E9-1)
V - BR
P shift position switch signal
IG switch ON and shift lever P position
10 to 14 V
↑
↑
↑
IG switch ON and shift lever except
P position
Below 1 V
N (E5-7) - E1 (E9-1)
GR - BR
N shift position switch signal
IG switch ON and shift lever N position
10 to 14 V
↑
↑
↑
IG switch ON and shift lever except
N position
Below 1 V
NSW (E7-16) - E1 (E9-1)
B-Y - BR
Park neutral switch signal
IG switch ON and shift lever P and
N position
Below 1 V
↑
↑
↑
IG switch ON and shift lever except
P and N position
10 to 14 V
DSL (E8-9) - E1 (E9-1)
Y-G - BR
S4 (E8-11) - E1 (E9-1)
L - BR
↑
↑
↑
↑
SL2+ (E8-15) - SL2- (E8-14)
L-Y - L-R
↑
↑
↑
IG switch ON
↑
↑
↑
1st or 2nd gear
10 to 14 V
↑
↑
↑
3rd or O/D gear
Below 1
SL1+ (E8-19) - SL1- (E8-18)
R-B - B-W
↑
↑
↑
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
↑
↑
↑
1st gear
10 to 14 V
↑
↑
↑
Except 1st gear
DSL solenoid signal
Vehicle speed 65 km/h (40 mph),
lock-up (ON to OFF)
S4 solenoid signal
IG switch ON
Below 1 V
↑
O/D gear
10 to 14 V
↑
Except O/D gear
Below 1 V
Engine idle speed
Pulse generation
(See waveform 3)
SL2 solenoid signal
SL1 solenoid signal
Pulse generation
(See waveform 2)
Below 1
Pulse generation
(See waveform 4)
Engine idle speed
Below 1
NC+ (E8-26) - NC- (E8-34)
Y - W-G
Speed sensor (NC) signal
Vehicle speed 30 km/h (19 mph):
(3rd gear)
Engine speed 1,400 rpm
NT+ (E8-27) - NT- (E8-35)
W - R-W
Speed sensor (NT) signal
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 5)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 6)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1097
05-908
DIAGNOSTICS
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
SLT+ (E8-13) SLT- (E8-12)
Y-R - B-Y
SLT solenoid signal
Engine idle speed
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
THO (E8-32) - E2 (E7-28)
G-Y - BR
ATF temperature sensor
signal
ATF temperature: 115 C (239 F)
or more
Below 1.5 V
L (E6-8) - E1 (E9-1)
R - BR
L shift position switch signal
IG switch ON and shift lever L position
10 to 14 V
↑
↑
↑
IG switch ON and shift lever except
L position
Below 1 V
2 (E6-9) - E1 (E9-1)
P - BR
2 shift position switch signal
IG switch ON and shift lever 2 position
10 to 14 V
↑
↑
↑
IG switch ON and shift lever except
2 position
Below 1 V
D (E6-10) - E1 (E9-1)
Y - BR
D shift position switch signal
IG switch ON and shift lever D position
10 to 14 V
↑
↑
↑
IG switch ON and shift lever except
D position
Below 1 V
R (E6-11) - E1 (E9-1)
L - BR
R shift position switch signal
IG switch ON and shift lever R position
10 to 14 V
↑
↑
↑
IG switch ON and shift lever except
R position
Below 1 V
SPD (E6-17) - E1 (E9-1)
Y - BR
STP (E6-19) - E1 (E9-1)
BR - BR
↑
↑
ODMS (E5-16) - E1 (E9-1)
GR - BR
↑
↑
Pulse generation
(See waveform 7)
Speed signal
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph)
Stop lamp switch signal
Brake pedal is depressed
7.5 to 14 V
Brake pedal is released
Below 1.5 V
↑
O/D main switch
↑
5 V/DIV
IG switch ON
10 to 14 V
IG switch ON and press continuously O/D main switch
Below 1 V
Waveform 1
Reference:
Terminal
SLT+ - SLT-
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 1ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
GND
1 ms/DIV
G23426
10 V/DIV
GND
Waveform 2
Reference:
Terminal
DSL - E1
Tool setting
10V/DIV, 100ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Vehicle speed 65 km/h (40 mph), lock-up (ON to OFF)
100 ms/DIV
C42677
C53420
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1098
DIAGNOSTICS
5 V/DIV
-
ELECTRONIC CONTROLLED AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE [ECT] (U241E/U140F)
05-909
Waveform 3
Reference:
Terminal
SL2+ - SL2-
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 1ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
GND
1 ms/DIV
G23426
5 V/DIV
Waveform 4
Reference:
Terminal
SL1+ - SL1-
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 1ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
GND
1 ms/DIV
G23426
1 V/DIV
GND
Waveform 5
Reference:
Terminal
NC+ - NC-
Tool setting
1V/DIV, 1ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Vehicle speed 30 km/h (19 mph): (3rd gear)
Engine speed 1,400 rpm
1 ms/DIV
C93866
5 V/DIV
GND
Waveform 6
Reference:
Terminal
NT+ - NT-
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 0.5ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph)
0.5 ms/DIV
C53419
C42920
5 V/DIV
Waveform 7
Reference:
Terminal
SPD - E1
Tool setting
5V/DIV, 20ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Vehicle speed 20 km/h (12 mph)
GND
20 ms/DIV
A05135
C53421
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1099
05-1722
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CF3-02
MUTE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (FROM TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The multi-display controller sub-assy controls the volume according to the MUTE signal from the television
display assy.
The MUTE signal is sent to reduce noise and a popping sound when modes, etc. are switched.
WIRING DIAGRAM
R28
Television Display Assy
MUTE
Multi-display Controller
Sub-assy
V
15
15
BK1
L
1
R31 MUTE
I34951
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1912
05-1723
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY)
(a)
Television Display Assy:
(b)
R28
MUTE
Disconnect the connector from the television display assy
and multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
MUTE - MUTE
Always
Specified condition
Below 1 Ω
MUTE - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
I37212
NG
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
R31
MUTE
I35962
I34943
OK
2
INSPECT TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY
(a)
(b)
Television Display Assy:
MUTE R28
Connect the television display assy connector.
Measure the voltage according to the values in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
MUTE - Body ground
DVD system sounding
Approx. 3.5 V
MUTE - Body ground
DVD system changing
Below 1.0 V
NG
I37213
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-26 )
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1913
05-1724
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CF4-03
SOUND SIGNAL CIRCUIT (FROM RADIO RECEIVER ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the sound signal circuit from the radio receiver assy to the multi-display controller sub-assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display Controller
Sub-assy
Radio Receiver Assy
SLD1
14
R23
18
IP1
(Shielded)
27
R29 SG2
RSL-
18
R23
BR
17
IP1
G
23
R29 R-L-
RSL+
17
R23
SB
16
IP1
R
24
R29 R-L+
16
R23
LG
15
IP1
W
RSR-
15
RSR+ R23
P
14
IP1
B
(Shielded)
25
R29 R-R26
R29 R-R+
I34952
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1914
05-1725
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(RADIO RECEIVER ASSY - MULTI-DISPLA Y
CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY)
(a)
Radio Receiver Assy:
R23
(b)
RSR+
RSLRSL+
RSR-
SLD1
I40203
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
R29
R-L-
SG2
R-R+
Disconnect the connector from the radio receiver assy
and multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
SLD1 - SG2
Always
Below 1 Ω
RSL- - R-L-
Always
Below 1 Ω
RSL+ - R-L+
Always
Below 1 Ω
RSR- - R-R-
Always
Below 1 Ω
RSR+ - R-R+
Always
Below 1 Ω
RSL- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
RSL+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
RSR- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
RSR+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
R-L+
R-R-
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
I34639
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1915
05-1726
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
Radio Receiver Assy:
RSL-
(a)
(b)
R23
Connect the connector.
Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform between the terminals according to the conditions, as
shown in the chart.
RSR+
RSL+
RSRI40577
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
RSL- - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
RSL+ - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
RSR- - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
RSR+ - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1916
05-1727
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CF5-02
SOUND SIGNAL CIRCUIT (FROM VIDEO (VIDEO ADAPTER)
TERMINAL)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the sound signal circuit from the video (video adapter) terminal to the multi-display controller subassy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
V13
Video (Video Adapter) Terminal
SGND
AUXR
AUXL
Multi-display Controller
Sub-assy
10
R30 SG7
(Shielded)
3
Y
12
R30 AUXR
BR
11
R30 AUXL
1
2
I34948
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1917
05-1728
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER
SUB-ASSY - VIDEO(VIDEO ADAPTER)TERMINAL)
(a)
Video (Video Adapter) Terminal:
(b)
V13
AUXL
SGND
AUXR
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
Disconnect the connector from the video (video adapter)
terminal and multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
SGND - SG7
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUXR - AUXR
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUXL - AUXL
Always
Below 1 Ω
AUXR - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
AUXL - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
R30
AUXR
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
AUXL
SG7
I40833
OK
2
INSPECT VIDEO(VIDEO ADAPTER) TERMINAL
(a)
(b)
Video (Video Adapter) Terminal:
Connect the connector.
Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform between the terminals according to the conditions, as
shown in the chart.
HINT:
External device system is playing (When the video (video
adapter) terminal is used).
AUXL
AUXR
V13
I37215
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AUXR - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
AUXL - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
NG
REPLACE VIDEO(VIDEO ADAPTER) TERMINAL
(See page 67-27 )
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1918
05-1729
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CF6-03
SOUND SIGNAL CIRCUIT (TO TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY
(HEADPHONE))
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the sound signal circuit from the multi-display controller sub-assy to the television display assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
Controller
Sub-assy
R28
Television Display Assy
GND1
HP2L
HP2R
GND
HP1R
HP1L
(Shielded)
25
BK1
L
24
BK1
BR
20
R30 HP2L
P
23
BK1
Y
21
R30 HP2R
(Shielded)
9
BK1
BR
7
BK1
R
9
R30 HP1R
Y
8
BK1
G
8
R30 HP1L
25
24
23
9
7
8
19
R30 SG6
(Shielded)
7
R30 SG5
(Shielded)
I34953
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1919
05-1730
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY)
(a)
Television Display Assy:
(b)
R28
HP1L
HP1R
GND
GND1
HP2R
HP2L
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
R30
HP1L
HP1R
SG5
HP2R
HP2L
Disconnect the connector from television display assy
and multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND1 - SG6
Always
Below 1 Ω
HP2L - HP2L
Always
Below 1 Ω
HP2R - HP2R
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND - SG5
Always
Below 1 Ω
HP1R - HP1R
Always
Below 1 Ω
HP1L - HP1L
Always
Below 1 Ω
HP2L - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
HP2R - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
HP1R - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
HP1L - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
SG6
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
I37216
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1920
05-1731
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECT MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY
(a)
(b)
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
HP1L
SG5
R30
HP1R
Connect the connector.
Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform between the terminals according to the conditions, as
shown in the chart.
HP2R HP2L SG6
I35265
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
HP2L - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
HP2R - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
HP1R - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
HP1L - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
NG
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLA Y
SUB-ASSY (See page 67-23 )
CONTROLLER
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1921
05-1732
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CF7-03
SOUND SIGNAL CIRCUIT (TO TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY
(WIRELESS HEADPHONE))
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the sound signal circuit from the television display assy to the multi-display controller sub-assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
Controller
Sub-assy
R28
Television Display Assy
(Shielded)
SLD
HPL-
HPL+
HPR-
HPR+
30
30
BK1
(Shielded)
20
R31 SLD1
P
29
BK1
G
16
R31 HPL-
LG
28
BK1
W
17
R31 HPL+
SB
27
BK1
R
18
R31 HPR-
BR
26
BK1
B
19
R31 HPR+
29
28
27
26
I34954
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1922
05-1733
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER
SUB-ASSY - TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY)
(a)
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
R31
(b)
HPL+
HPL-
SLD1
HPRHRL+
Television Display Assy:
R28
Disconnect the connector from the multi-display controller sub-assy and television display assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
SLD - SLD1
Always
Below 1 Ω
HPL- - HPL-
Always
Below 1 Ω
HPL+ - HPL+
Always
Below 1 Ω
HPR- - HPR-
Always
Below 1 Ω
HPR+ - HPR+
Always
Below 1 Ω
HPL- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
HPL+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
HPR- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
HPR+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
SLD
HPL-
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
HPL+
HRL+
HPR-
I37217
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1923
05-1734
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECT MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY
(a)
(b)
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
R31
SLD1
Connect the connector.
Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform between the terminals according to the conditions, as
shown in the chart.
HPL-
HPR-
HPR+
HPL+
I35265
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
HPL- - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
HPL+ - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
HPR- - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
HPR+ - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
NG
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLA Y
SUB-ASSY (See page 67-23 )
CONTROLLER
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1924
05-1735
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CF8-02
SOUND SIGNAL CIRCUIT (FROM TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the sound signal circuit from the television display assy to the multi-display controller sub-assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
Controller
Sub-assy
R28
Television Display Assy
SGND
AL-
AR-
AL+
AR+
(Shielded)
10
10
BK1
(Shielded)
6
R31 SG4
G
14
BK1
G
2
R31 AL-
W
12
BK1
W
4
R31 AR-
R
13
BK1
R
3
R31 AL+
B
11
BK1
B
14
12
13
11
5
R31 AR+
I34955
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1925
05-1736
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY)
(a)
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
(b)
R31
AL-
Disconnect the connector from the television display assy
and multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
SGND - SG4
Always
Below 1 Ω
AL- - AL-
Always
Below 1 Ω
AR- - AR-
Always
Below 1 Ω
AL+ - AL+
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG4
AL+
AR+
ARTelevision Display Assy:
R28
AR+ - AR+
Always
Below 1 Ω
AL- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
AR- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
AL+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
AR+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
ALAL+
AR- AR+
SGND
I37217
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1926
05-1737
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECT TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY
(a)
(b)
Television Display Assy:
AL-
AL+ R28
AR- AR+
Connect the connector.
Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform between the terminals according to the conditions, as
shown in the chart.
I37213
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
AL- - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
AR- - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
AL+ - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
AR+ - Body ground
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform synchronized with sound is output
NG
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY
(See page 67-26 )
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1927
05-1738
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CF9-02
DISPLAY SIGNAL CIRCUIT (TO TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the display signal circuit from the multi-display controller sub-assy to the television display assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
Controller
Sub-assy
R28
Television Display Assy
R
G
B
VR
SYNC
VG
22
G
22
BK1
G
21
W
21
BK1
W
20
R
20
BK1
R
18
Y
18
BK1
Y
19
B
19
BK1
B
17
(Shielded)
17
BK1
13
R30 R2
14
R30 G2
15
R30 B2
17
(Shielded)
R30 VR2
16
R30 SYN2
18
R30 VG2
I34946
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1928
05-1739
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY)
(a)
Television Display Assy:
(b)
R28
Disconnect the connector from the television display assy
and multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
R - R2
Always
Below 1 Ω
G - G2
Always
Below 1 Ω
VG
R
G
B
VR
SYNC
B - B2
Always
Below 1 Ω
SYNC - SYN2
Always
Below 1 Ω
Below 1 Ω
VR - VR2
Always
VG - VG2
Always
Below 1 Ω
R - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
G - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
B - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
SYNC - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
VR - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
R30
R2
VG2
VR2
G2
SYN2
B2
I37216
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1929
05-1740
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CFA-02
DISPLAY SIGNAL CIRCUIT (FROM TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the display signal circuit from the television display assy to the multi-display controller sub-assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
R28
Television Display Assy
S. GND
NTSC
SG
Multi-display Controller
Sub-assy
31
BR
31
BK1
R
9
R31 SGN2
32
Y
32
BK1
G
8
R31 NTS2
16
(Shielded)
16
BK1
(Shielded)
10
R31 SG9
I34949
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1930
05-1741
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY)
(a)
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
(b)
R31
SG9
SGN2
Disconnect the connector from the television display assy
and multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
S. GND - SGN2
Always
Below 1 Ω
NTSC - NTS2
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG - SG9
Always
Below 1 Ω
NTSC - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NTS2
Television Display Assy:
R28
NG
SG
NTSC
S. GND
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
I37217
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1931
05-1742
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CFB-03
DISPLAY SIGNAL CIRCUIT (FROM VIDEO (VIDEO ADAPTER)
TERMINAL)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the display signal circuit from the video (video adapter) terminal to the multi-display controller subassy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
Controller
Sub-assy
V13
Video (Video Adapter) Terminal
22
R30 SG6
(Shielded)
SLD
7
NTSC
G
24
R30 NTS4
R
23
R30 SGN5
5
SGND
6
I34947
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1932
05-1743
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER
SUB-ASSY - VIDEO(VIDEO ADAPTER)TERM)
(a)
Video (Video Adapter) Terminal:
(b)
V13
NTSC
SLD
SGND
Disconnect the connector from the video (video adapter)
terminal and multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
SLD - SG6
Always
Below 1 Ω
NTSC - NTS4
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGND - SGN5
Always
Below 1 Ω
NTSC - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
R30
NG
NTS4
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
SGN5
SG6
I40833
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1933
05-1746
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CFC-02
AVC-LAN CIRCUIT (MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Each unit of the rear seat entertainment system connected with AVC-LAN (communication bus) transfers
the signal of each switch by communication.
When +B short and GND short occur in this AVC-LAN, the rear seat entertainment system will not function
normally as the communication is discontinued.
WIRING DIAGRAM
R28
Television Display Assy
TX+
TX-
Multi-display Controller
Sub-assy
5
O
5
BK1
P
5
R30 TX2+
4
V
4
BK1
LG
4
R30 TX2-
I34971
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1936
05-1747
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
SERVICE CHECK MODE(TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY)
Perform service check.
(1) Start the diagnosis system and read check result for television display assy.
Standard:
A
”NCON” is displayed or no display (Rr-TV)
B
”OK” is displayed
B
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLA Y
SUB-ASSY (See page 67-23 )
CONTROLLER
A
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY)
(a)
Television Display Assy:
(b)
R28
TX+
TX-
Disconnect the connector from the television display assy
and multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
TX+ - TX2+
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX- - TX2-
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX+ - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
TX- - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Multi display Controller Sub-assy:
R30
NG
TX2+
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
TX2I37216
OK
REPLACE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY (See page 67-26 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1937
05-1720
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CF2-03
MUTE SIGNAL CIRCUIT (FROM RADIO RECEIVER ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Multi-display controller sub-assy controls the volume according to the RMUT signal from the radio receiver assy.
The RMUT signal is sent to reduce noise and a popping sound when modes, etc. are switched.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display Controller
Sub-assy
Radio Receiver Assy
19
RMU R23
O
3
IP1
L
28
R29 RMUT
I34950
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1910
05-1721
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(RADIO RECEIVER ASSY - MULTI-DISPLA Y
CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY)
(a)
Radio Receiver Assy:
R23
Disconnect the connector from the radio receiver assy
and multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
(b)
RMU
Tester connection
Condition
RMU - RMUT
Always
Specified condition
Below 1 Ω
RMU - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
I40203
NG
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
R29
RMUT
I34639
OK
2
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
Radio Receiver Assy:
(a)
(b)
R23
RMU
Connect the radio receiver assy connector.
Measure the voltage according to the values in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
RMU - Body ground
Audio system sounding
Approx. 3.5 V
RMU - Body ground
Audio system changing
Below 1.0 V
NG
I40577
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
(SEE PAGE 67-6 )
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(SEE PAGE 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1911
05-1744
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05IVA-01
VIDEO (VIDEO ADAPTOR) TERMINAL SET SIGNAL CIRCUIT
WIRING DIAGRAM
V13
Video (Video Adapter) Terminal
CE
8
Multi-display
Controller Sub-assy
3
R30 GAUX
SB
I41227
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1934
05-1745
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(VIDEO (VIDEO ADAPTOR) TERMINAL MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY)
(a)
Video (Video Adapter) Terminal:
(b)
CE
V13
Disconnect the video (video adapter) terminal and multidisplay controller sub-assy connectors.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
CE - GAUX
Always
Specified condition
Below 1 Ω
CE - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
GAUX
R30
I40833
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1935
05-1748
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05AU5-04
A REMOTE CONTROL SYSTEM DOES NOT OPERATE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
(a)
CHECK BATTERY(SWITCH & VOLUME ASSY)
Check battery.
(1) Check that the dry-cell battery used for the switch & volume assy is not dead.
Standard: It is not dead
NG
BATTERY IS DEAD
OK
2
CLEAN THE INFRARED RAY EMITTED PORTION
(a)
Infrared Ray Emitted Portion
Clean the infrared ray emitted portion.
(1) Clean the infrared ray emitted portion on the television display assy.
(2) Check whether the same malfunction occurs.
Standard: The function returns to normal.
NG
I40585
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-1704 )
OK
NORMAL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1938
05-1715
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05ATT-04
POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT(MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER
SUB-ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit is the power source circuit to operate the multi-display controller sub-assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B
W
CRT
2
1
J17
J/C
16
IK2
V
2
V
Passenger Side J/B
8
4D
A
A
B
1
1H
RAD No.2
1
1A
AM1
1
F7
FL Block
2
ALT
3
W
1
16
R29 +B1
32
R29 ACC
G
G
A
I15
Ignition SW
Instrument Panel J/B
Y
Y
J18
J/C
14
IO1
W
21
IO2
V
A
2
2
4E
Multi-display
Controller Sub-assy
2
1C
L
6
1C
W
3 ACC
AM1 2
2
W-B
7
R31 SELD
W-B
29
R29 GND
C
J18
J/C
FL MAIN
C
C
W-B
Battery
BF
I37210
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1905
05-1716
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY(+B1, ACC, GND, SELD)
(a)
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
ACC
R29
R31
+B1
SELD
GND
(b)
I37211
(c)
Disconnect the connector from the multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SELD - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Measure the voltage according to the values in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
+B1 - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1906
05-1717
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CF1-03
POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT(TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit is the power source circuit to operate the television display assy. The power source is sent from
the battery to the television display assy through the multi-display controller sub-assy.
WIRING DIAGRAM
R28
Television Display Assy
+B
ACC
GND
Multi-display
Controller Sub-assy
1
G
1
BK1
V
1
R30 +B2
2
GR
2
BK1
GR
2
R30 ACC2
6
W-B
6
BK1
W-B
6
R30 GND1
I34945
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1907
05-1718
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY(+B, ACC, GND)
(a)
Television Display Assy:
(b)
R28
+B
GND
(c)
ACC
I37212
Disconnect the connector from the television display
assy.
Measure the resistance according to the value in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
GND - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Measure the voltage according to the values in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
+B - GND
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC - GND
Ignition SW ACC
10 to 14 V
NG
Go to step 2
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (See page
05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1908
05-1719
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY)
(a)
Television Display Assy:
(b)
R28
+B
GND
ACC
I37212
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy:
Disconnect the connector from the multi-display controller sub-assy.
Measure the resistance according to the values in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
+B - +B2
Always
Below 1 Ω
Below 1 Ω
ACC - ACC2
Always
GND - GND1
Always
Below 1 Ω
+B - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
ACC - Body ground
Always
10 kΩ or higher
NG
R30
GND1
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
+B2
ACC2
I35960
I36913
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-1704 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1909
05-1695
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05ATN-04
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
RSE SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
VIN
Production Date
Customer’s Name
Licence Plate No.
Brought-in Date
/
/
/
Date of First Occurrence
Frequency of Problem Occurrence
km
mile
Odometer Reading
Constant
/
Intermittent (
Times a day)
Problem
Symptom
Switch & Volume Assy
Headphone
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy
Disc Player Controller (Built in ”Television Display Assy”)
Television Display Assy
DTC
Check
Parts name
DTC (1st time)
DTC (2nd time)
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy
Disc Player Controller
Television Display Assy
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1885
05-1691
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CEY-02
DESCRIPTION
1.
(a)
OUTLINE OF AVC-LAN
What is AVC-LAN?
AVC-LAN is the abbreviation for Audio Visual Communication-Local Area Network. This is a unified
standard co-developed by 6 audio manufacturers associated with Toyota Motor Corporation.
The unified standard includes signals, such as audio, visual and signals for switch indication and communication.
Stereo Component
Amplifier Assy
Example:
Network
Gateway ECU
Multi-display Controller
Sub-assy
Multi-display Assy
Radio Receiver Assy
Navigation ECU
: AVC-LAN
I34376
(b)
Objectives
Recently developments in car audio systems have been rapid and functions have been changed drastically. The conventional system has been switched to the multi-media type such as a navigation system. At the same time, customers want to upgrade their audio systems. This is the factor that lies behind this standardization.
The concrete objectives are explained below.
(1) When products by different manufacturers were combined together, malfunctions such as sound
failure occurred. This problem can be solved by standardization of signals.
(2) Various types of after market products are available.
(3) Because of the above (2), each manufacturer has been able to concentrate on developing products in their strongest field. This has enabled the development of inexpensive products.
(4) In general, a new product developed by one particular manufacturer could not be used due to
a lack of compatibility with other manufacturers’ products. By developing this new standard, users can enjoy a range of compatible products from different manufacturers anytime they want.
HINT:
When +B short or GND short is detected in AVC-LAN circuit, communication stops, and the audio system does not function normally.
When audio system is not equipped with a navigation system, the audio head unit is the master unit.
When the audio system is equipped with a navigation system, the radio receiver is the master unit.
The master unit is equipped with a resistor (60 to 80 Ω) for communication.
The car audio system using AVC-LAN circuit has a diagnosis function.
Each product has its own specified number called a physical address (three-digit number). Numbers
are also allotted to each function within a product, which are called logical addresses (two-digit number).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1881
05-1692
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
This system performs communication between components through the Main AVC-LAN and Sub
AVC-LAN.
Main AVC-LAN
Radio Receiver Assy
Television Display Assy
Sub AVC-LAN
Multi-display
Controller Sub-assy
I35063
(b)
The multi-display controller sub-assy functions as a master unit, which performs communication between the multi-display controller sub-assy and television display assy, in the Sub AVC-LAN circuit.
HINT:
Refer to ”LEXUS NAVIGATION SYSTEM” (See page 05-1757 ) and ”AUDIO SYSTEM” (See page 05-1615 )
for the Main AVC-LAN circuit.
(c)
3.
(a)
The multi-display controller sub-assy is equipped with a resistor (60 to 80 Ω) for communication.
DIAGNOSIS FUNCTION
The multi-display controller sub-assy functions as a master unit in the Sub AVC-LAN circuit on this
circuit. It identifies trouble in this circuit, and the identified information is displayed on the television
display assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1882
05-1712
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05ATP-05
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Terms
Meaning
Physical address
Three-digit code (shown in hexadecimal) which is given to each component comprising the AVC-LAN.
Corresponding to the function, individual symbols are specified.
Logical address
Two-digit code (shown in hexadecimal) which is given to each function in the inner
system of the AVC-LAN.
HINT:
The DTC of the Main AVC-LAN circuit is displayed on the radio receiver assy or multi-display, and the DTC
of the Sub AVC-LAN circuit is displayed on the television display assy.
Titles for each unit are stated in the following order: physical address, (parts name) and [name indicated on
the DTC display].
1.
MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY (Physical address: 16C, 16D) [RSE-ECU]
HINT:
*1: Even if no failure is detected, this code may be stored depending on the battery condition or voltage
for starting the engine.
*2: This code is stored 180 seconds after the power supply connector is disconnected after engine
start.
*3: This code may be stored when the engine key is turned back to the ON position and then turned
again to the START position after engine start.
*4: This code may be stored when the engine key is turned back to the ON position and then turned
again to the START position in 1 minute after engine start.
(a) Logical address: 01 (Communication control)
DTC
D8
*2
D9
*1
DA
DB
*1
DC
*4
Diagnosis item
Condition
Countermeasure and inspected parts
No Response To Connection Check
Component shown by sub-code is or had
been disconnected from system after engine
start.
1. Check harness for power supply system
of component shown by sub-code.
2. Check harness for communication system of component shown by sub-code.
Last Mode Error
Component operated (sound and/or image
was provided) before engine stop is or was
disconnected with ignition switch in the ACC
or ON position.
1. Check harness for power supply of component shown by sub-code.
2. Check harness for communication system of component shown by sub-code.
No Response to ON/OFF Instruction
No response is identified when changing
mode (audio and visual mode change).
Detected when sound and picture do not
change by button operation.
1. Check harness for power supply system
of component shown by sub-code.
2. Check harness for communication system of component shown by sub-code.
3. If error occurs again, replace component
shown by auxiliary code.
Mode Status Error
Dual alarm is detected.
1. Check harness for power supply system
of component shown by sub-code.
2. Check harness for communication system of component shown by sub-code.
Transmission Error
Transmission to component shown by subcode failed.
(This code does not necessarily mean actual failure.)
If same sub-code is recorded in other component(s), check harness for power supply
and communication system of all components shown by code.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1902
05-1713
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
DE
*3
E4
*1
Diagnosis item
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
Condition
Countermeasure and inspected parts
Slave Reset (Momentary Interruption)
After engine start, slave component has
been disconnected.
1. Check harness for power supply system
of component shown by sub-code.
2. Check harness for communication system of component shown by sub-code.
Multiple Frame Abort
Multiple frame transmission is aborted.
Since this DTC is provided for engineering
purpose, it may be detected when no actual
failure exists.
2.
TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY (Physical address: 1B0) [Rr-TV]
HINT:
*1: Even if no failure is detected, this code may be stored depending on the battery condition or voltage
for starting the engine.
*2: This code may be stored when the engine key is turned again in 1 minute after the engine start.
*3: This code may be stored when the engine key is turned again after the engine start.
*4: The code is stored 210 seconds after the power supply connector of the master component is disconnected with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position.
(a) Logical address: 01 (Communication control)
DTC
22
D6
*1
D7
*4
DC
*2
Diagnosis item
RAM Error
Condition
Countermeasure and inspected parts
Abnormal condition of RAM is detected.
Replace television display assy
Component in which this code is recorded
was disconnected from system with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position. Or,
when this code was recorded, multi-display
controller sub-assy was disconnected.
1. Check harness for power supply of multi-display controller sub-assy (see page
05-1715 ).
2. Check harness for communication system of multi-display controller sub-assy
(see page 05-1864 ).
3. Check harness for power supply of television display assy (see page 05-1717 ).
4. Check harness for communication system of television display assy (see page
05-1746 ).
Communication Check Error
Component in which this code is recorded is
or was disconnected from system after engine start. Or, when recording this code,
multi-display controller sub-assy was disconnected.
1. Check harness for power supply of multi-display controller sub-assy (see page
05-1715 ).
2. Check harness for communication system of multi-display controller sub-assy
(see page 05-1864 ).
3. Check harness for power supply of television display assy (see page 05-1717 ).
4. Check harness for communication system of television display assy (see page
05-1746 ).
Transmission Error
Transmission to component shown by subcode failed.
(Detecting this DTC does not necessarily
mean actual failure.)
If the same sub-code is recorded in other
components, check harness for power supply and communication system of all components shown by code.
Absence of Master
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1903
05-1714
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
Diagnosis item
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
Condition
Countermeasure and inspected parts
Master Reset (Momentary Interruption)
After engine start, multi-display controller
sub-assy was disconnected from system.
1. Check harness for power supply of multi-display controller sub-assy (see page
05-1715 ).
2. Check harness for communication system of multi-display controller sub-assy
(see page 05-1864 ).
3. If this error occurs frequently, replace
multi-display controller sub-assy.
DF
*4
Master Error
Due to defective condition of component
with a display, master function is switched to
audio equipment.
Error occurs in communication between
sub-master (audio) and master component.
1. Check harness for power supply of multi-display controller sub-assy (see page
05-1715 ).
2. Check harness for communication system of multi-display controller sub-assy
(see page 05-1864 ).
E0
*1
Registration Completion Instruction Error
”Registration Completion Instruction” command from master cannot be received.
Since this DTC is provided for engineering
purposes, it may be detected when no actual failure exists.
E2
ON/OFF Instruction Parameter Error
Error occurs in ON/OFF controlling command from multi-display controller subassy.
Replace multi-display controller sub-assy.
E3
*1
Registration Request Transmission
Registration Request command is output
from slave component.
Registration Connection Check Instruction,
Registration Request command is output
from sub-master component.
Since this DTC is provided for engineering
purposes, it may be detected when no actual failure exists.
E4
*1
Multiple Frame Abort
Multiple frame transmission is aborted.
Since this DTC is provided for engineering
purposes, it may be detected when no actual failure exists.
DD
*3
(b)
Logical address: 44 (DVD)
DTC
Diagnosis item
Condition
Countermeasure and inspected parts
42
No Disc Readout
Disc cannot be read.
Inspect disc
44
DVD Error
Error is detected in disc player controller.
Inspect disc, Television display assy
45
EJECT Error
Disc cannot be ejected.
Inspect disc, Television display assy
46
Disc Crack
A crack or dirt is in a disc.
Inspect disc, Television display assy
52
Player Error
Clamp malfunction occurs.
Inspect disc, Television display assy
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1904
05-1693
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05ATM-04
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
1
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
2
Customer Problem Analysis (See page 05-1695 )
(a)
Interview and confirm the trouble.
(1) Confirm the condition of the trouble.
3
(a)
Basic Inspection
Basic inspection.
(1) Measure the battery voltage.
Standard: 11 to 14 V
w/ Navigation system:
Check the power supply to the multi-display assy.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position.
(2) Check whether or not the display appears on the multi-display assy.
(b)
Display does not appear (Proceed to problem
symptom table ”Black Screen (Multi Display
Assy)”) (See page 05-1778 ).
Display appears (Go to step 4).
(c)
w/o Navigation system:
Check the power supply to the radio receiver assy.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position.
(2) Check whether or not the display appears on the radio receiver assy.
Display does not appear (Proceed to problem
symptom table) (See page 05-1632 )
Display appears (Go to step 4).
4
(a)
Check Body Multiplex Communication System (See page 05-2040 )
Check that the DTC is output.
DTC is not output (Go to step 5).
DTC is output
(Proceed to ”Body Multiplex Communication
System”).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1883
05-1694
DIAGNOSTICS
5
(a)
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
DTC Check (See page 05-1696 )
Check that the DTC is output.
DTC is output (Go to step 6).
DTC is not output (Go to step 7).
6
DTC Chart (See page 05-1712 )
Go to step 8
7
Problem Symptom Table (See page 05-1704 )
8
Circuit Inspection and Part Inspection (See page 05-1715 - 05-1748 )
9
Identification of Problem
10
Repair or Replace
11
Confirmation Test
End
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1884
05-1690
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05ATQ-04
LOCATION
Television Display Assy
(Disc Player Controller)
Engine Room J/B
CRT Fuse
FL Block
ALT Fuse
w/o 3rd seat:
Multi-display Controller
Sub-assy
Video (Video Adapter)
Terminal
Instrument Panel J/B
RAD No.2 Fuse
AM1 Fuse
w/ 3rd seat:
Multi-display Controller
Sub-assy
Multi-display
Radio Receiver Assy
I40586
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1880
05-1696
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CEZ-02
PRE-CHECK
1.
DIAGNOSIS CHECK
HINT:
Diagnosis system mode is operated as follows.
RSE system normal operation
Diagnosis start-up w/ Navigation system (See page 05-1784 )
w/o Navigation system (See page 05-1618 )
Start-up of the diagnostics function for the ”audio system
and navigation system” is linked with the start-up of the
diagnostic function of the ”rear display”.
Select ”MENU” and enter
”Diagnosis MENU” using a
remote controller.
Enter
”Service Check Mode.”
(See step 2)
Enter
”Display Check.”
(See step 3)
I35064
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1886
05-1697
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
HINT:
RSE system inspects the devices consisting of Sub AVC-LAN
multi-display controller sub-assy.
(a) Starting Main AVC-LAN diagnosis mode (See page
05-1784 , 05-1618 ).
HINT:
Starting Main AVC-LAN operates the diagnosis mode,
and sub AVC-LAN also automatically enters the diagnosis mode and performs the diagnosis mode operation on
the multi-display controller sub-assy.
Use a switch & volume assy to operate diagnosis mode.
(b) Finishing the diagnosis mode.
Turn the ignition switch off to finish the diagnosis mode.
Switch &
Volume Assy:
I35000
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1887
05-1698
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
2.
SERVICE CHECK MODE
HINT:
”Service Check Mode” is operated as follows.
Enter
”Diagnosis MENU.”
(See step 1)
Recheck
Master Component
Registration clearance
DTC memory clearance
DTC clear
I36928
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1888
05-1699
DIAGNOSTICS
(a)
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
Service Check Mode
(1) Start the Diagnosis System.
Display Item
*6
Component Names/*1
Component names including optional
components (15 components max.) are
displayed. When the names are not
identified, their physical addresses are
displayed.
Check Result/*2
Check results are displayed.
Memory Clear switch/*3
Pressing this switch for 3 sec. deletes all
the information about master component
registration.
DTC Clear switch/*4
Pressing this switch for 3 sec. deletes
diagnosis memory of all the components.
It deletes the check results.
Recheck/*5
Pressing this switch performs Service
Check again.
MENU/*6
Pressing this switch activates the Diagnosis Menu screen.
LAN Monitor screen switch/*7
Pressing this switch activates the LAN
Monitor screen, which displays the logical address 01 with DTC D0 - FE.
*2
*1
*1
*7
*4
*3
Function
*5
I35066
Components:/*1
Display
RSE-ECU
Name
Multi-display Controller Sub-assy
Rr-TV
Television Display Assy
HINT:
Service Check displays the check results based on the information obtained from each component’s response to ”System
Check Execution” and ”Diagnosis Memory Request”, and the
information of ”Current DTC Notification” (the ”Unit Check” that
will be displayed on the next screens).
(2) Read Check Result
Check Result
Meaning
OK
No DTC is identified.
EXCH
One or more DTCs requesting an exchange are detected.
CHEK
One or more DTCs requesting a check are detected.
NCON
No connection response to Diagnosis System start-up,
however it has connection response to the AVC LAN system when the power switch is turned on (when IG is turned
to the ACC position).
Old
One or more DTCs are detected because of old version.
NRES
No response to the information about the Diagnosis System,
whereas it responds to the Diagnosis System start-up.
HINT:
After repairing and checking, press ”Code CLR” for more
than 3 seconds to delete diagnosis memory.
After deleting diagnosis memory, press ”Recheck” and
make sure ”OK” is displayed on the screen.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1889
05-1700
DIAGNOSTICS
-
(3)
*1
*3
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
”EXCH”, ”CHEK” and ”Old” can be used as switches
to activate ”Unit Check Mode” for detailed information. When inspecting the malfunctioning area, refer
to the DTC code list.
Display Item
*2
*5
*6
Component name/*1
Name of component to be checked is
displayed.
DTC clear switch/*2
Pressing this switch for 3 sec. deletes
DTC memory of the selected diagnosis
component.
Service check mode screen switch/*3
Pressing this returns to the Service
Check Mode screen.
Date/Time/*4
The date and time stamped at the time of
DTC occurrence are displayed in the order of year-month-day-hour-minutesecond. (If the date and time data is invalid, it is displayed as a blank.)
Current/ *5
Up to 6 DTC codes detected during the
System Check are displayed.
Memory/ *6
DTC memories stored and current DTC
notification are displayed.
*4
I35067
Description
HINT:
Detecting unit DTC activates the ”Unit Check Mode” on
the screen.
In the ”Unit Check Mode”, DTCs which are identified as
”EXCH” in the ”Service Check” are classified into ”Current” DTC and ”Past” DTC.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1890
05-1701
DIAGNOSTICS
-
(4)
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
”CHECK” can be used as a switch to activate ”LAN
Monitor” for detailed information. When inspecting
the malfunctioning area, refer to the DTC code list.
Display Item
I35068
*1
*4
*2
*5
Description
Component name/*1
Names of component to be checked are
displayed.
Segment/*2
Logical address codes corresponding to
DTC are displayed.
DTC/*3
DTC is displayed.
Sub-Code (address numbers of related
components)/*4
Physical address codes memorized together with DTC are displayed.
Sub-code (Connection confirmation
number) /*5
Connection confirmation numbers memorized together with DTC are displayed.
Sub-code (Number of occurrence) /*6
The number of occurrence of the same
DTC is displayed.
HINT:
*6
*3
I35069
Detecting no LAN DTC activates the LAN Monitor on the
screen.
The LAN Monitor chooses and displays the LAN DTC out
of DTC of components identified as ”CHEK” in the LAN
Monitor.
(5) Read Check Result
Check Result
Meaning
OK
No DTC is identified.
CHEK
One or more DTCs requesting a check are detected.
NCON
No connection response to Diagnosis System start-up,
however it has connection response to the AVC-LAN system when the power switch is turned on (when IG is turned
to the ACC position).
NRES
No response to the information about the Diagnosis System,
whereas it responds to the Diagnosis System start-up.
Old
One or more DTCs are detected because of old version.
HINT:
After repairing and checking, press ”Code CLR” for more
than 3 seconds to delete diagnosis memory.
After deleting diagnosis memory, press ”Recheck” and
make sure ”OK” is displayed on the screen.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1891
05-1702
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
3.
DISPLAY CHECK MODE
HINT:
Display check mode is operated as follows.
Enter
”Diagnosis MENU.”
(See step 1)
Select color by
remote control
operation
Press ENTER on
remote control
The entire screen is changed
to the color which is selected
in the color bar check mode.
I35070
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1892
05-1703
DIAGNOSTICS
(a)
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
Display Check Mode
Display
*1
Contents
Color Bar Check/*1
Color display is checked.
Remote Commander/*2
Operating condition of remote commander display is checked.
*2
HINT:
In Display Check Mode, above checks can be performed.
I35071
(b)
Select color by
remote control
operation
Press ENTER
on remote
control
The entire screen is
changed to the color
which is selected in
the color bar check
mode.
Display Color Bar Check
(1) Start the Diagnosis System.
(2) Select ”MENU”.
(3) Select ”Display Check”.
(4) Select ”Color Bar Check”.
(5) Make sure that each color name is corresponding
to each color on the bar.
HINT:
Select Black, Red, Green, Blue, White and Stripe to display selected colors and stripe on the entire screen.
(6) Compare the color with the ”Color Bar Check”, and
make sure that the color is the same.
I35072
(c)
Display Remote Commander Check
(1) Start the Diagnosis system.
(2) Select ”MENU”.
(3) Select ”Display Check”.
(4) Select ”Remote Commander”.
(5) Press each switch and make sure that it corresponds to the display on the screen.
I35073
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1893
05-1704
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05ATS-04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Inspect the ”Fuse” and ”Relay” before confirming the suspected area as shown in the charts below.
TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY:
Symptom
Suspected Area
See page
1. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
2. Power source circuit (television display assy)
3. AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy television display assy)
4. Multi-display controller sub-assy
05-1715
05-1717
05-1746
Display screen is not stabilized (Synchronous error).
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
Power source circuit (television display assy)
Display signal circuit (To television display)
Television display assy
Multi-display controller sub-assy
05-1715
05-1717
05-1738
67-26
67-23
Color on display screen is unusual (RGB signal error).
1.
2.
3.
4.
Rear display color bar check of display check mode
Display signal circuit (To television display)
Television display assy
Multi-display controller sub-assy
05-1696
05-1738
67-26
67-23
Black screen.
67-23
DISC PLAYER CONTROLLER (Built in ”TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY”):
Symptom
Suspected Area
See page
Only DVD screen is not displayed or not stabilized.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
Power source circuit (television display assy)
Display signal circuit (From television display)
Television display assy
Multi-display controller sub-assy
05-1715
05-1717
05-1740
67-26
67-23
Only DVD is not heard or the sound quality is poor.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
Power source circuit (television display assy)
Sound signal circuit (From television display assy)
RSE sound signal circuit (RSE-Radio receiver assy)
Mute signal circuit (From television display assy)
AMP mute signal circuit (From RSE ECU)
Multi-display controller sub-assy
Television display assy
05-1715
05-1717
05-1735
05-1671
05-1722
67-23
67-26
VIDEO (VIDEO ADAPTER) TERMINAL:
Symptom
Only display screen input from the external device is not displayed or not stabilized.
Only sound quality input from the external device is poor or no
sound can be heard.
The operation to the external device cannot be performed.
Suspected Area
See page
1. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
2. Power source circuit (television display assy)
3. Display signal circuit (From video (video adapter) terminal)
4. VIDEO (Video adapter) terminal
5. Multi-display controller sub-assy
05-1715
05-1717
05-1742
1. Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
2. Power source circuit (television display assy)
3. Sound signal circuit (From video (video adapter) terminal)
4. VIDEO (Video adapter) terminal
5. Multi-display controller sub-assy
05-1715
05-1717
05-1727
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
05-1715
05-1717
05-1744
67-27
67-23
Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
Power source circuit (television display assy)
VIDEO (Video adapter) terminal set signal circuit
VIDEO (Video adapter) terminal
Multi-display controller sub-assy
67-27
67-23
67-27
67-23
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1894
05-1705
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
RSE SYSTEM:
Symptom
Suspected Area
See page
Quality of sound from wireless headphone is poor or no sound
can be heard.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
Power source circuit (television display assy)
Sound signal circuit (Wireless headphone)
Multi-display controller sub-assy
Television display assy
05-1715
05-1717
05-1732
67-23
67-26
Quality of sound from headphone connected to headphone terminal is poor or no sound can be heard.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
Power source circuit (television display assy)
Sound signal circuit (Headphone)
Multi-display controller sub-assy
Television display assy
05-1715
05-1717
05-1729
67-23
67-26
1.
2.
3.
4.
A remote control system does not operate
Power source circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy)
Power source circuit (television display assy)
AVC-LAN circuit (multi-display controller sub-assy television display assy)
REMOTE CONTROL:
Symptom
A remote control system does not operate.
Suspected Area
See page
05-1748
05-1715
05-1717
05-1746
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1895
05-1706
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
05CF0-03
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY
R29
R31
R30
I34999
Symbols (Terminals No.)
L- - GND
(R29-7 - R29-29)
L+ - GND
(R29-8 - R29-29)
R- - GND
(R29-9 - R29-29)
Wiring Color
G - W-B
R - W-B
W - W-B
Terminal Description
Condition
Specification
DVD system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
DVD system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
DVD system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Sound signal (Output)
DVD system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
Sound signal (Output)
Sound signal (Output)
Sound signal (Output)
R+ - GND
(R29-10 - R29-29)
B - W-B
SG1 - Body ground
(R29-11 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
LMUT - GND
(R29-12 - R29-29)
V - W-B
Mute signal
Disc player changer or disc player
controller is changing
Below 1 V
+B1 - GND
(R29-16 - R29-29)
Y - W-B
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
TX3+ (R29-17)
BR
AVC-LAN
communication signal
See ”Service Check Mode”
-
TX3- (R29-18)
Y
AVC-LAN
communication signal
See ”Service Check Mode”
-
TX- (R29-30)
GR
AVC-LAN
communication signal
See ”Service Check Mode”
-
TX+ (R29-31)
LG
AVC-LAN
communication signal
See ”Service Check Mode”
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1896
05-1707
DIAGNOSTICS
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
SG33 - Body ground
(R29-19 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
SGN1 - Body ground
(R29-20 - Body ground)
R - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
NTS1 - GND
(R29-21 - R29-29)
G - W-B
Display signal
DVD system is displayed
Pulse generation
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Sound signal (Input)
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
Mute signal
Audio source is changing
Below 1 V
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
R-L- - GND
(R29-23 - R29-29)
R-L+ - GND
(R29-24 - R29-29)
R-R- - GND
(R29-25 - R29-29)
G - W-B
R - W-B
W - W-B
Sound signal (Input)
Sound signal (Input)
Sound signal (Input)
R-R+ - GND
(R29-26 - R29-29)
B - W-B
SG2 - Body ground
(R29-27 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
RMUT - GND
(R29-28 - R29-29)
L - W-B
GND - Body ground
(R29-29 - Body ground)
W-B - Body ground
ACC - GND
(R29-32 - R29-29)
G - W-B
Ignition (ACC)
Ignition switch in the ACC position
10 to 14 V
+B2 - GND
(R30-1 - R29-29)
V - W-B
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC2 - GND
(R30-2 - R29-29)
GR - W-B
Ignition (ACC)
Ignition switch in the ACC position
10 to 14 V
Ground
External device system is playing
(At that time of VTR jack use)
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
GAUX - GND
(R30-3 - R29-29)
SB - W-B
TX2- (R30-4)
LG
AVC-LAN
communication signal
See ”Service Check Mode”
-
TX2+ (R30-5)
P
AVC-LAN
communication signal
See ”Service Check Mode”
-
GND1 - Body ground
(R30-6 - Body ground)
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
SG5 - Body ground
(R30-7 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
Sound signal (Input)
External device system is playing
(At that time of VTR jack use)
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Sound signal (Input)
External device system is playing
(At that time of VTR jack use)
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Ground
Always
HP1L - GND
(R30-8 - R29-29)
G - W-B
HP1R - GND
(R30-9 - R29-29)
R - W-B
SG7 - Body ground
(R30-10 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
Below 1 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1897
05-1708
DIAGNOSTICS
AUXL - GND
(R30-11 - R29-29)
BR - W-B
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
Sound signal
External device system is playing
(At that time of VTR jack use)
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
AUXR - GND
(R30-12 - R29-29)
Y - W-B
Sound signal
External device system is playing
(At that time of VTR jack use)
R2 - GND
(R30-13 - R29-29)
G - W-B
Display signal (Red)
Display is on
(Television display assy)
Pulse generation
G2 - GND
(R30-14 - R29-29)
W - W-B
Display signal (Green)
Display is on
(Television display assy)
Pulse generation
B2 - GND
(R30-15 - R29-29)
R - W-B
Display signal (Blue)
Display is on
(Television display assy)
Pulse generation
SYN2 - GND
(R30-16 - R29-29)
B - W-B
Display signal
(Synchronize)
Display is on
(Television display assy)
Pulse generation
VR2 - Body ground
(R30-17 - Body ground)
Y - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
VG2 - Body ground
(R30-18 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
SG6 - Body ground
(R30-19 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
Sound signal (Output)
Audio system is playing (Headphone)
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Sound signal (Output)
Audio system is playing (Headphone)
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
HP2L - GND
(R30-20 - R29-29)
BR - W-B
HP2R - GND
(R30-21 - R29-29)
Y - W-B
SG6 - Body ground
(R30-22 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
SGN5 - Body ground
(R30-23 - Body ground)
R - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
NTS4 - GND
(R30-24 - R29-29)
G - W-B
Display signal
External device system displayed
(At that time of VTR jack use)
Pulse generation
MUTE - GND
(R31-1 - R29-29)
L - W-B
Mute signal
Disc player controller is changing
Below 1 V
AL- - GND
(R31-2 - R29-29)
AL+ - GND
(R31-3 - R29-29)
AR- - GND
(R31-4 - R29-29)
G - W-B
R - W-B
W - W-B
AR+ - GND
(R31-5 - R29-29)
B - W-B
SG4 - Body ground
(R31-6 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
DVD system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
DVD system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
DVD system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Sound signal (Input)
DVD system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Ground
Always
Sound signal (Input)
Sound signal (Input)
Sound signal (Input)
Below 1 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1898
05-1709
DIAGNOSTICS
SELD - Body ground
(R31-7 - Body ground)
W-B - Body ground
NTS2 - GND
(R31-8 - R29-29)
G - W-B
SGN2 - Body ground
(R31-9 - Body ground)
SG9 - Body ground
(R31-10 - Body ground)
HPL- - GND
(R31-16 - R29-29)
HPL+ - GND
(R31-17 - R29-29)
HPR- - GND
(R31-18 - R29-29)
2.
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
Ground
Always
Display signal
DVD system is displayed
R - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
Shielded - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
G - W-B
W - W-B
R - W-B
HPR+ - GND
(R31-19 - R29-29)
B - W-B
SLD1 - Body ground
(R31-20 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
Below 1 V
Pulse generation
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Sound signal (Output)
RSE system is playing
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Ground
Always
Sound signal (Output)
Sound signal (Output)
Sound signal (Output)
Below 1 V
TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY
R28
I35015
Terminals No. (Symbols)
Wiring Color
+B - GND
(R28-1 - R28-6)
G - W-B
ACC - GND
(R28-2 - R28-6)
GR - W-B
TX- (R28-4)
Condition
Condition
Specification
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
Ignition (ACC)
Ignition switch in the ACC position
10 to 14 V
V
AVC-LAN
communication signal
See ”Service Check Mode”
-
TX+ (R28-5)
O
AVC-LAN
communication signal
See ”Service Check Mode”
-
GND - Body ground
(R28-6 - Body ground)
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Sound signal (Input)
While voice sound is being produced
HP1R - GND
(R28-7 - R28-6)
BR - W-B
Below 1 V
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1899
05-1710
DIAGNOSTICS
HP1L - GND
(R28-8 - R28-6)
Y - W-B
GND - Body ground
(R28-9 - Body ground)
SGND - Body ground
(R28-10 - Body ground)
AR+ - GND
(R28-11 - R28-6)
AR- - GND
(R28-12 - R28-6)
AL+ - GND
(R28-13 - R28-6)
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Sound signal (Input)
While voice sound is being produced
Shielded - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
Shielded - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
B - W-B
W - W-B
R - W-B
Sound signal (Output)
Sound signal (Output)
Sound signal (Output)
DVD system is sounding
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
DVD system is sounding
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
DVD system is sounding
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
AL- - GND
(R28-14 - R28-6)
G - W-B
Sound signal (Output)
DVD system is sounding
MUTE - GND
(R28-15 - R28-6)
V - W-B
Mute signal
DVD system is sounding → DVD
system is changing
3.5 V →
Below 1 V
SG - Body ground
(R28-16 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
VG - Body ground
(R28-17 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
VR - Body ground
(R28-18 - Body ground)
Y - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
SYNC - VR
(R28-19 - R28-18)
B-Y
Display signal
(Synchronize)
Television display is ON
Pulse generation
B - VR
(R28-20 - R28-18)
R-Y
Display signal (Blue)
Television display is ON
Pulse generation
G - VR
(R28-21 - R28-18)
W-Y
Display signal (Green)
Television display is ON
Pulse generation
R - VR
(R28-22 - R28-18)
G-Y
Display signal (Red)
Television display is ON
Pulse generation
Sound signal (Input)
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Sound signal (Input)
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Ground
Always
Sound signal (Input)
While voice sound is being produced
HP2R - GND
(R28-23 - R28-6)
P - W-B
HP2L - GND
(R28-24 - R28-6)
L - W-B
GND1 - Body ground
(R28-25 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
HPR+ - GND
(R28-26 - R28-6)
BR - W-B
Below 1 V
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1900
05-171 1
DIAGNOSTICS
HPR- - GND
(R28-27 - R28-6)
HPL+ - GND
(R28-28 - R28-6)
SB - W-B
LG - W-B
-
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM
Sound signal (Input)
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Sound signal (Input)
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
Sound signal (Input)
While voice sound is being produced
A waveform
synchronized
with sound is
output
HPL- - GND
(R28-29 - R28-6)
P - W-B
SLD - Body ground
(R28-30 - Body ground)
Shielded - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
S. GND - Body ground
(R28-31 - Body ground)
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
NTSC - GND
(R28-32 - R28-6)
Y - W-B
Display signal
Rear display is on
Pulse generation
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
1901
05-10
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ESL-05
BASIC INSPECTION
When the malfunction is not confirmed in the DTC check, troubleshooting should be carried out in all the
possible circuits considered as possible causes of the problem. In many cases, by carrying out the basic
engine check shown in the following flowchart, the problem can be found quickly and efficiently. Therefore,
using this check is essential in the engine troubleshooting.
1
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
NOTICE:
Carry out the battery voltage check with the engine stopped and ignition switch OFF.
Voltage
NG
OK
NG
11 V or more
Less than 11 V
CHARGE OR REPLACE BATTERY
OK
2
CHECK IF ENGINE WILL CRANK
NG
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
ON PAGE 05-31
NG
Go to step 7
OK
3
CHECK IF ENGINE STARTS
OK
4
CHECK AIR FILTER
Visually check if the air filter is contaminated with dirty or oily.
NG
CLEAN OR REPLACE
OK
5
CHECK IDLE SPEED (See page 14-1 )
NG
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
ON PAGE 05-31
OK
6
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE (See page 11-4 )
NG
PROCEED TO PAGE 11-4 AND CONTINUE TO
TROUBLESHOOT
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
200
05-1 1
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK FOR SPARK (See page 18-3 )
NG
PROCEED TO PAGE 18-1 AND CONTINUE TO
TROUBLESHOOT
OK
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE ON PAGE 05-31
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
201
05-24
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05MOJ-01
CHECKING MONITOR STATUS
NOTICE:
The monitor status (mode 6) is not applicable to the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S). However, HO2S
test values can be checked by O2S TEST RESULT (mode 5). Refer to page 05-22
1.
Outline
The monitor results and the test values can be checked with the OBDII scan tool.
The engine control module (ECM) monitors the emissions-related components as the thermostat, catalyst
converter and evaporative emissions (EVAP), and determines whether they are functioning normally or not.
When finished monitoring, the ECM stores the monitor results and the test values.
The monitor result indicates whether the component is functioning normally or not. The test value is the value
that was used to determine the monitor result. If the test value is outside the test limit (malfunction criterion),
the ECM determines the component is malfunctioning. Some emissions-related components have multiple
test values to determine monitor result. If one of these test values is outside test limit, the ECM determines
the component is malfunctioning.
2.
Description
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. This information is
included under ”MONITOR RESULT” in the emissions-related DTC sections:
TID $08: Thermostat
TLT
CID
Unit Conversion
1
$01
Multiply by 0.625 and
subtract 40 [C]
Description of Test Value
Description of Test Limit
ECT sensor output when estimated ECT Malfunction criterion for thermostat
has reached to malfunction criterion
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBDII scan tools.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
214
05-25
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Procedure (using hand-held tester)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch and hand-held tester ON.
Clear DTCs.
Allow the vehicle to drive, in accordance with the applicable drive pattern described in the READINESS
MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN section (see page 05-26 ).
(e)
MONITOR RESULT
CATALYST#1 B1 . INCMP
CATALYST#1 B2 . INCMP
O2S HEAT B1S1 . INCMP
O2S HEAT B1S2 . INCMP
O2S HEAT B2S1 . INCMP
O2S HEAT B2S2 . INCMP
THERMOSTAT . . . . . PASS
Press [ENTER] to
Select the Label .
Select the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED OBDII, MONITOR INFO and MONITOR RESULT. The monitor result appears after the component
name.
INCMP indicates the component has not been monitored
yet.
PASS indicates the component is functioning normally.
FAIL indicates the component is malfunctioning.
A82674
(f)
Thermostat malfunction
VAL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119.375C
LMT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75.000C
TLT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
(g)
[HELP] to notice
[EXIT] to return
A82675
Select the component and press ENTER. If the monitor
result has been PASS or FAIL, the accuracy test value appears.
VAL indicates the test value.
LMT indicates the test limit (malfunction criterion).
TLT indicates the test limit type.
Compare the test value with the test limit.
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test
value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test
value is lower than the test limit.
If the test value is on the borderline of the test limit, a malfunction is concealed in the component.
HINT:
The monitor result might on rare occasions be PASS even if the
malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is illuminated. This indicates
the system malfunctioned on a previous driving cycle. This
might be caused by an intermittent problem.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
215
05-9
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ESK-05
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
Hand-held tester only:
Inspect the vehicle’s ECM using check mode. Intermittent problems are easier to detect when the
ECM is in check mode with the hand-held tester. In check mode, the ECM uses 1 trip detection logic,
which has a higher sensitivity to malfunctions than normal mode (default), which uses 2 trip detection logic.
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page 05-38 ).
(b) Set the check mode (see page 05-40 ).
(c) Perform a simulation test (see page 01-26 ).
(d) Check the connector and terminal (see page 01-36 ).
(e) Wiggle the harness and the connector (see page 01-36 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
199
05-40
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ITD-02
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
Hand-held Tester
DLC3
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
Check mode has a higher sensitivity to malfunctions and can
detect malfunctions that normal mode cannot detect. Check
mode can also detect all the malfunctions that normal mode can
detect.
1.
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE (Using the hand-held
tester)
(a) Make sure that the items below are true:
(1) Battery positive voltage 11 V or more
(2) Throttle valve fully closed
(3) Transmission in the P or N position
(4) A/C switched OFF
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
A80020
(e)
0.13 seconds
ON
OFF
0.13 seconds
A76900
Change the ECM to check mode with the hand-held tester. Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / CHECK MODE. Make sure the MIL
flashes as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
All DTCs and freeze frame data recorded will be erased if:
1) the hand-held tester is used to change the ECM from
normal mode to check mode or vice-versa; or 2) during
check mode, the ignition switch is turned from ON to ACC
or OFF.
(f)
Start the engine. The MIL should turn off after the engine
starts.
(g) Simulate the conditions of the malfunction described by
the customer.
(h) After simulating the malfunction conditions, use the
hand-held tester diagnosis selector to check the DTC,
freeze frame data and other data.
(1) After checking the DTC, inspect the applicable circuit.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
230
05-41
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
3.
Engine Room J/B
(a)
EFI NO. 1
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CLEAR DTC (Using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held
tester)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to
the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Erase DTCs and freeze frame data with the OBD II scan
tool (complying with SAE J1978) or the hand-held tester.
For the hand-held tester: 1) enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CLEAR
CODES; and 2) press YES. For the OBD II scan tool, see
its instruction manual.
CLEAR DTC (Not using the OBD II scan tool or handheld tester)
Remove the EFI NO. 1 fuse from the engine room J/B and
ETCS fuse from the engine room R/B No. 2 for more than
60 seconds.
Or, disconnect the battery cable for more than 60 seconds. After disconnecting the battery terminal, perform
the ”INITIALIZE” procedure (see page 05-893 ).
Engine Room R/B No. 2
ETCS
P
A90343
A80017
A91474
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
231
05-1
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ESI-05
DEFINITION OF TERMS
Term
Definition
Monitor description
Description of what the ECM monitors and how it detects malfunctions (monitoring purpose and its details).
Related DTCs
A group of diagnostic trouble codes that are output by the ECM based on the same malfunction detection logic.
Typical enabling condition
Preconditions that allow the ECM to detect malfunctions.
With all preconditions satisfied, the ECM sets the DTC when the monitored value(s) exceeds the malfunction
threshold(s).
Sequence of operation
The priority order that is applied to monitoring, if multiple sensors and components are used to detect the malfunction.
When a sensor is being monitored, the next sensor or component will not be monitored until the current sensor
monitoring is finished.
Required sensor/components
The sensors and components that are used by the ECM to detect malfunctions.
Frequency of operation
The number of times that the ECM checks for malfunctions per driving cycle.
”Once per driving cycle” means that the ECM detects the malfunction only one time during a single driving cycle.
”Continuous” means that the ECM detects the malfunction every time an enabling condition is met.
Duration
The minimum time that the ECM must sense a continuous deviation in the monitored value(s) before setting a
DTC. This timing begins after the ”typical enabling conditions” are met.
Malfunction thresholds
Beyond this value, the ECM will conclude that there is a malfunction and set a DTC.
MIL operation
MIL illumination timing after a defect is detected.
”Immediate” means that the ECM illuminates the MIL the instant the ECM determines that there is a malfunction.
”2 driving cycles” means that the ECM illuminates the MIL if the same malfunction is detected again in the 2nd
driving cycle.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
191
05-35
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ESO-05
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
DESCRIPTION
When troubleshooting On-Board Diagnostic (OBD II) vehicles, the vehicle must be connected to the OBD II scan
tool (in compliance with SAE J1978) or the hand-held
tester. Various data output from the vehicle’s ECM can
then be read.
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle’s on-board
computer illuminates the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer detects
a malfunction in: 1) the emission control system/components, or 2) the powertrain control components (which affect vehicle emissions), or 3) the computer. In addition,
the applicable Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the ECM memory
(see page 05-48 ).
If the malfunction does not reoccur in 3 consecutive trips, the
MIL turns off automatically but the DTCs remain recorded in the
ECM memory.
FI0534
Hand-held Tester
DLC3
A80020
To check DTCs, connect the hand-held tester or OBD II
scan tool to the Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3) of the vehicle. The hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool also enables you to erase the DTC and check the freeze frame
data and various forms of engine data (see the instruction
manual for the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester).
The DTC includes SAE controlled codes and manufacturer controlled codes. SAE controlled codes must be set according to the SAE, while manufacturer controlled codes
can be set by a manufacturer with certain restrictions (see
the DTC chart on page 05-48 ).
The diagnosis system operates in ”normal mode” during
normal vehicle use. In ”normal mode”, 2 trip detection logic* is used to ensure accurate detection of malfunctions.
A ”check mode” is also available to technicians as an option. In ”check mode”, 1 trip detection logic is used for simulating malfunction symptoms and increasing the system’s ability to detect malfunctions, including intermittent
malfunctions (hand-held tester only) (see page 05-40 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
225
05-36
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
*2 trip detection logic:
When a malfunction is first detected, the malfunction is
temporarily stored in the ECM memory (1st trip). If the
ignition switch is turned OFF and then ON again, and the
same malfunction is detected again, the MIL will illuminate (2nd trip).
Freeze frame data:
The freeze frame data records the engine conditions (fuel
system, calculated load, engine coolant temperature, fuel
trim, engine speed, vehicle speed, etc.) when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped,
if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio
was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Priorities for troubleshooting:
When multiple DTCs occur, find out the order in which the DTCs
should be inspected by checking the component’s DTC chart.
If no instructions are written in the DTC chart, check DTCs in the
following order of priority:
(a) DTCs other than fuel trim malfunction DTCs (P0171 and
P0172) and misfire DTCs (P0300 to P0304).
(b) Fuel trim malfunction DTCs (P0171 and P0172).
(c) Misfire DTCs (P0300 to P0304).
2.
CG
SG
SIL
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10111213141516
DLC3
CHECK DLC3
The vehicle’s ECM uses the ISO 9141-2 for communication protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 9141-2 format.
BAT
A04550
Symbol
Terminal No.
Name
Reference terminal
Result
Condition
SIL
7
Bus ”+” line
5 - Signal ground
Pulse generation
During transmission
CG
4
Chassis ground
Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Always
SG
5
Signal ground
Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Always
BAT
16
Battery positive
Body ground
9 to 14 V
Always
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
226
05-37
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
HINT:
Connect the cable of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3, turn the ignition switch ON and attempt to use
the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester. If the screen displays UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE, a problem exists
in the vehicle side or the tester side.
If the communication is normal when the tool is connected
to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on the original vehicle.
If the communication is still impossible when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in
the tool itself. Consult the Service Department listed in the
tool’s instruction manual.
3.
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard: 11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge the battery before proceeding.
4.
CHECK MIL
(a) The MIL turns on when the ignition switch is turned ON
and the engine is not running.
HINT:
If the MIL does not turn on, troubleshoot the MIL circuit (see
page 05-359 ).
(b) When the engine is started, the MIL should turn off. If the
lamp remains on, the diagnosis system has detected a
malfunction or abnormality in the system.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
227
05-43
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
05ESS-05
DATA LIST/ACTIIVE TEST/SYSTEM CHECK/SYSTEM CHECK
1.
DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the hand-held tester DATA LIST allows switch, sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in troubleshooting is one way to shorten labor time.
NOTICE:
In the table below, the values listed under ”Normal Condition” are reference values. Do not depend
solely on the these reference values when deciding whether a part is faulty or not.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(e) Turn ON the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
(f)
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST.
(g) According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Hand-held Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition*
Diagnostic Note
Injection period/
Minimum: 0 ms, Maximum: 32.64 ms
Idling: 1.92 to 3.37 ms
-
Ignition timing advance/
Minimum: -64 deg., Maximum: 63.5 deg.
Idling: BTDC 5 to 15 deg.
-
Calculated load by ECM/
Minimum: 0 %, Maximum: 100 %
Idling: 3.3 to 26.7 %
Racing without load (2500 rpm):
12.0 to 14.7 %
-
MAF
Air flow rate from MAF meter/
Minimum: 0 gm/s, Maximum: 655 gm/s
Idling:
0.58 to 4.67 gm/second
Racing without load (2,500 rpm):
3.33 to 9.17 gm/second
If value is approximately 0.0 gm/s:
Mass air flow meter power
source circuit open
VG circuit open or short
If value is 160.0 gm/s or more:
EVG circuit open
ENGINE SPD
Engine Speed/
Minimum: 0 rpm, Maximum: 16,383 rpm
Idling:
550 to 750 rpm
INJECTOR
IGN ADVANCE
CALC LOAD
-
After warming up: 80 to 95°C
(176 to 203°F)
If value is -40C (-40F): sensor
circuit is open
If value is 140C (284F) or
more:
sensor circuit is shorted
Intake air temperature/
Minimum: -40C, Maximum: 140C
Equivalent to ambient temperature
(after cold soak)
If value is -40C (-40F): sensor
circuit is open
If value is 140C (284F) or
more:
sensor circuit is shorted
Absolute throttle position sensor/
Minimum: 0 %, Maximum: 100 %
Throttle fully closed: 6 to 16 %
Throttle fully open: 64 to 98 %
Read value with ignition switch ON
(do not start engine)
Closed throttle position switch/
ON or OFF
Throttle fully closed: ON
Throttle open: OFF
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed/
Minimum: 0 km/h, Maximum: 255 km/h
Vehicle stopped: 0 km/h (0 mph)
Speed indicated on speedometer
ACCEL POS #1
Accelerator pedal position sensor No.1
output voltage/
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 5 V
Accelerator released:
0.5 to 1.1 V
Accelerator depressed:
2.6 to 4.5 V
Read value with ignition switch ON
(do not start engine)
ACCEL POS #2
Accelerator pedal position sensor No. 2
output voltage/
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 5 V
Accelerator released:
1.2 to 2.0 V
Accelerator depressed:
3.4 to 5.3 V
Read value with ignition switch ON
(do not start engine)
COOLANT TEMP
INTAKE AIR
THROTTLE POS
CTP SW
Coolant temperature/
Minimum: -40C, Maximum: 140C
Author:
-
Date:
233
05-44
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
Hand-held Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
THROTTLE POS #2
Throttle position sensor No. 2 output voltage/ Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 5 V
Throttle fully closed: 2.1 to 3.1 V
Throttle fully open: 4.5 to 5.5 V
Read value with ignition switch ON
(do not start engine)
THROTTLE TARGT
Target position of throttle valve/
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 5 V
Idling: 0.4 to 1.1 V
Read value with ignition switch ON
(do not start engine)
Throttle fully closed: 0 %
When accelerator pedal is depressed, duty ratio is increased
Read value with ignition switch
ON (do not start engine)
Normal Condition*
Diagnostic Note
THROTTLE OPN DUTY
Throttle actuator opening duty ratio/
Minimum: 0 %, Maximum: 100 %
THROTTLE CLS DUTY
Throttle actuator closed duty ratio/
Minimum: 0 %, Maximum: 100 %
Throttle fully open: 0 %
When accelerator pedal is quick
released, duty ratio is increased
Read value with ignition switch
ON (do not start engine)
Whether or not throttle actuator control is
permitted/ ON or OFF
Idling: ON
Read value with ignition switch ON
(do not start engine)
Whether or not electric throttle control
system power is input/
ON or OFF
Idling: ON
-
Vapor Pressure/
Minimum: 97.175 kPa, Maximum:
103.425 kPa
Usable range: 60 to 110 kPa
Pressure inside of fuel tank as
read by vapor pressure sensor
Idling: 0.1 to 0.9 V
Performing INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL function of ACTIVE TEST
enables technician to check voltage output of each sensor
Performing INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL function of ACTIVE TEST
enables technician to check voltage output of each sensor
THROTTLE MOT
+BM
VAPOR PRESS
O2S B1 S2
Oxygen sensor output voltage of the
bank 1 sensor 2/
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 1.275 V
AFS B1 S1
A/F sensor output voltage of the bank 1
sensor 1/
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 7.999 V
Idling: 2.8 to 3.8 V
ACCEL IDL POS
Whether or not accelerator pedal position
sensor is detecting idle/
ON or OFF
Idling: ON
THROTTLE IDL POS
Whether or not throttle position sensor is
detecting idle/
ON or OFF
Idling: ON
FAIL #1
Whether or not fail safe function is
executed/ ON or OFF
ETCS has failed: ON
FAIL #2
Whether or not fail safe function is
executed/ ON or OFF
ETCS has failed: ON
THROTTLE INITIAL
Throttle fully closed
(learned value)
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 5 V
0.5 to 0.9 V
ACCEL LEARN VAL
Accelerator fully closed
(learned value)
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 5 V
0.4 to 0.8 V
Throttle motor current
Minimum: 0 A, Maximum: 20 A
Idling: 0 to 3.0 A
Short term fuel trim of bank 1/
Minimum: -100 %, Maximum: 100 %
0 ± 20 %
This item is short-term fuel compensation used to maintain air-fuel
ratio at stoichiometric air-fuel ratio
This item is overall, long-term fuel
compensation that helps to maintain air-fuel ratio at stoichiometric
air fuel ratio (steadies long term
deviations of short-term fuel trim
from central value).
THROTTLE MOT
SHORT FT #1
LONG FT #1
Long term fuel trim of bank 1/
Minimum: -100 %, Maximum: 100 %
0 ± 20 %
TOTAL FT #1
Total fuel trim of bank 1/
Minimum: 0.5, Maximum: 1.496
Idling: 0.5 to 1.4
Author:
-
Date:
234
05-45
DIAGNOSTICS
Hand-held Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
AF FT B1 S1
Short term fuel trim associated with bank
1, sensor 1/
Minimum: 0, Maximum: 1.999
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
Normal Condition*
Diagnostic Note
Value less than 1 (0.000 to
0.999) = LEAN
Stoichiometric Air-Fuel Ratio=1
Value greater than 1 (1.001 to
1.999) = RICH
-
Fuel system status (Bank 1) /
OL or CL or OL DRIVE or
OL FAULT or CL FAULT
Idling after warming up: CL
OL (Open Loop) : Has not yet satisfied conditions to go closed
loop
CL (Closed Loop) : Using heated
oxygen sensor(s) as feed back
for fuel control
OL DRIVE: Open loop due to
driving conditions (fuel enrichment)
OL FAULT: Open loop due to detected system fault
CL FAULT: Closed loop but one
of heated oxygen sensors, which
is used for fuel control, is malfunctioning
FC IDL
Idle fuel cut/ ON or OFF
Fuel cut operation: ON
FC IDL = ON when throttle valve
is fully closed and engine speed is
over 1,500 rpm
MIL
MIL status/ ON or OFF
MIL ON: ON
-
Starter signal/ ON or OFF
Cranking: ON
-
A/C signal/ ON or OFF
A/C ON: ON
-
PNP switch signal/ ON or OFF
P or N position: ON
-
Electrical load signal/ ON or OFF
Defogger switch ON: ON
-
Stop lamp switch/ ON or OFF
Brake pedal depressed: ON
Brake pedal released: OFF
-
Power steering signal/ ON or OFF
While turning steering wheel: ON
While not turning steering wheel:
OFF
Idle-up control is performed when
PS is ON
Power steering signal/
ON or OFF
When steering wheel is turned
This signal is usually ON until Ignition switch is turned OFF
FUEL PUMP / SPD
Fuel pump / speed status /
ON/H or OFF/M,L
Idling: ON
-
A/C MAG CLUTCH
A/C magnet clutch status /
ON or OFF
A/C magnet clutch ON: ON
-
EVAP VSV
EVAP VSV status control /
ON or OFF
VSV operating: ON
VVT CTRL B1
VVT control status (Bank 1) /
ON or OFF
VVT system operation: ON
-
IGNITION
Ignition counter/ Minimum: 0,
Maximum: 400
0 to 400
-
Misfire ratio of cylinder 1 to 4/
Minimum: 0 %, Maximum: 50 %
0%
MISFIRE LOAD
Engine load for first misfire range/
Minimum: 0 g/rev, Maximum: 3.98 g/rev.
Misfire 0: 0 g/rev.
MISFIRE RPM
Engine RPM for first misfire range/
Minimum: 0 rpm, Maximum: 6,375 rpm
Misfire 0: 0 rpm
FC TAU
Fuel Cut TAU: Fuel cut during very light
load/ ON or OFF
Fuel cut operating: ON
Fuel cut is being performed under
very light load to prevent engine
combustion from becoming incomplete
Check mode/ ON or OFF
Check mode ON: ON
See page 05-40
FUEL SYS #1
STARTER SIG
A/C SIG
PNP SW [NSW]
ELECT LOAD SIG
STOP LIGHT SW
PS OIL PRESS SW
PS SIGNAL
CYL #1, #2, #3, #4
CHECK MODE
EVAP VSV is controlled by ECM
(ground side duty control)
This item is displayed in only idling
Author:
Date:
235
05-46
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
HINT:
*: If no conditions are specifically stated for ”ldling”, the shift lever is in the N or P position, the A/C switch
is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
2.
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the hand-held tester ACTIVE TEST allows relay, VSV, actuator and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to shorten
labor time. The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(e) Turn ON the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
(f)
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST.
(g) According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST.
Hand-held Tester Display
INJ VOL
A/F CONTROL
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
[Test Details]
Control injection volume
Minimum: -12.5 %, Maximum: 25 %
[Vehicle Condition]
Engine speed: 3000 rpm or less
All injectors are tested at once
Injection volume is gradually
changed between -12.5 and 25
%
[Test Details]
Control injection volume
-12.5 or 25 % (change the injection volume -12.5 % or 25 %)
[Vehicle Condition]
Engine speed: 3000 rpm or less
Following A/F CONTROL procedure enables technician to check
and graph voltage outputs of both
A/F sensor and heated oxygen
sensor
For displaying the graph, enter
”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL /
USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1
and O2S B1S2” by pressing ”YES”
and push ”ENTER”, Then press
”F4”
EVAP VSV (ALONE)
[Test Details]
Activate EVAP VSV control
ON or OFF
-
A/C MAG CLUTCH
[Test Details]
Control A/C magnet clutch
ON or OFF
-
FUEL PUMP / SPD
[Test Details]
Control fuel pump
ON or OFF
-
[Test Details]
Vacuum pump
ON or OFF
-
[Test Details]
Vent valve
ON or OFF
-
VCUUM PUMP (ALONE)
VENT VALVE (ALONE)
VVT CTRL B1
TC/TE1
FC IDL PROHBT
[Test Details]
Activate VVT system (Bank 1)
ON or OFF
ON: Rough idle or engine stall
OFF: Normal engine speed
[Test Details]
Connect TC and TE1
ON or OFF
-
[Test Details]
Control idle fuel cut prohibit
ON or OFF
-
Author:
Date:
236
05-47
DIAGNOSTICS
Hand-held Tester Display
TC/TE1
FC IDL PROHBT
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
[Test Details]
Connect TC and TE1
ON or OFF
-
[Test Details]
Control idle fuel cut prohibit
ON or OFF
-
3.
SYSTEM CHECK
HINT:
Performing the hand-held tester SYSTEM CHECK allows the system which is composed of multiple actuators to be operated without removing any parts.
Operate the system by performing SYSTEM CHECK and check for DTCs. And, potential malfunctions in the
system can be detected on the tester.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn ON the ignition switch and the hand-held tester.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK.
(d) According to the display on the tester, perform the ”SYSTEM CHECK.
Hand-held Tester Display
EVAP SYS CHECK
(AUTO OPERATION)
EVAP SYS CHECK
(MANUAL OPERATION)
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
EVAP key-off monitor is operated automatically by performing 7 steps
in order.
Fuel temperature: 35C (95F) or less is recommended
If there is no DTC displayed on
PENDING DTC after SYSTEM
CHECK, system is functioning
normally
Refer to EVAP INSPECTION
PROCEDURE
(on page 05-317 )
EVAP key-off monitor is operated manually by performing 7 steps in
order.
Fuel temperature: 35C (95F) or less is recommended
Used to detect a malfunctioning
part
Refer to EVAP INSPECTION
PROCEDURE
(on page 05-317 )
Author:
Date:
237
05-38
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ESP-05
DTC CHECK/CLEAR
Hand-held Tester
DLC3
A80020
NOTICE:
If no DTC appears in normal mode:
On the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester check
the pending fault code using the Continuous Test Results function (Mode 7 for SAE J1979).
When the diagnosis system is changed from normal
mode to check mode or vice-versa, all DTCs and
freeze frame data recorded in normal mode will be
erased. Before changing modes, always check and
make a note of DTCs and freeze frame data.
1.
CHECK DTC (Using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held
tester)
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Use the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to check
the DTCs and freeze frame data and then write them
down.
For the hand-held tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES. For the OBD II scan tool, see its instruction manual.
(d) See page 05-48 to confirm the details of the DTCs.
NOTICE:
When simulating a symptom with the OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester) to check for DTCs, use the normal mode. For DTCs subject to ”2 trip detection logic”, perform either of the following actions.
Turn the ignition switch OFF after the symptom is
simulated once. Then repeat the simulation process
again. When the problem has been simulated twice,
the MIL illuminates and the DTCs are recorded in the
ECM.
Check the pending fault code using the Continuous
Test Results function (Mode 7 for SAE J1979) on the
OBD II scan tool.
2.
CLEAR DTC (Using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held
tester)
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to
the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Erase DTCs and freeze frame data with the OBD II scan
tool (complying with SAE J1978) or the hand-held tester.
For the hand-held tester: 1) enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CLEAR
CODES; and 2) press YES. For the OBD II scan tool, see
its instruction manual.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
228
05-39
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
Engine Room J/B
(a)
EFI NO. 1
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CLEAR DTC (Not using the OBD II scan tool or handheld tester)
Remove the EFI NO. 1 fuse from the engine room J/B and
ETCS fuse from the engine room R/B No. 2 for more than
60 seconds. Or, disconnect the battery terminal for more
than 60 seconds.
After disconnecting the battery cable, perform the ”INITIALIZE” procedure (see page 05-893 ).
Engine Room R/B No. 2
ETCS
P
A90343
A80017
A91474
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
229
05-312
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVZ-05
ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned ON, battery voltage is applied to terminal IGSW of the ECM. The ECM
”MREL” output signal causes current to flow to the coil, closing the contacts of the EFI relay (Marking: EFI)
and supplying power to terminal +B of the ECM.
If the ignition switch is turned OFF, the ECM holds the EFI relay ON for a maximum of 2 seconds to allow
for the initial setting of the throttle valve.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
1
GR
IGN
6
4
1G
1C
Passenger Side J/B
W
1
4M
ECM
J6
J/C
P
4E
P
E
E
9
E5
IGSW
6
IG2
I15
Ignition
Switch
AM2
7
Y
1
IC1
L-Y
F7
10 FL Block Assy
AM2
Engine Room J/B
1
3 W
2I
EFI Relay
EFI
NO. 1
5
3
4
10
W
2B
W
IK2
1
E5
+B
1
W
FL
Main
W-B
4
5
2F
2B
2
1
13
IK3
P-L
B
8
E5
BR
1
E9
J7
J/C
A
BR
A
A
J2
J/C
MREL
E1
Battery
EH
EE
A90306
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
502
05-313
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT ECM (+B VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
(a)
(b)
+B (+)
E5
ECM
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage between of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
OK
A67446
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-1 (+B) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN ON PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-31 )
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
E1
E9
ECM
A81698
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-1 (E1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (IGSW VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
IGSW (+)
E5
ECM
A67446
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-9 (IGSW) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
Go to step 6
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
503
05-314
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK FUSE (IGN)
(a)
(b)
Instrument
Panel J/B
Assy
Remove the IGN fuse from the instrument panel J/B Assy.
Measure the resistance of the IGN fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
IGN Fuse
A90344
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
5
INSPECT IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSY
(a)
I15
Ignition
Switch
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
Measure the resistance of the ignition switch terminals.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Condition
Specified Condition
LOCK
6 (IG2) - 7 (AM2)
10 kΩ or higher
ON
6 (IG2) - 7 (AM2)
Below 1 Ω
NG
AM2
IG2
A56879
REPLACE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSY
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BATTERY - IGNITION SWITCH, IGNITION
SWITCH - ECM)
6
INSPECT ECM (MREL VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
MREL (+)
E5
ECM
A67446
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-8 (MREL) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
504
05-315
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK FUSE (EFI NO. 1)
(a)
(b)
Engine Room J/B
EFI NO. 1 fuse
A90343
Remove the EFI NO. 1 fuse from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance of the EFI NO. 1 fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
8
INSPECT RELAY (EFI)
1
3
1
5
2
2
5
(a)
(b)
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
505
05-316
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (EFI RELAY - ECM, EFI RELAY - BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Engine Room J/B
(a)
Check the wire harness between the EFI relay and ECM.
(1) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
(2) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
EFI Relay
(b)
E5
ECM
A90291
A67445
MREL
A92643
Specified Condition
J/B EFI relay terminal 1 - E5-8 (MREL)
Below 1 Ω
J/B EFI relay terminal 1 or E5-8 (MREL) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Check the wire harness between the EFI relay and body
ground.
(1) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
(2) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector and the body ground.
Standard:
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
J/B EFI relay terminal 2 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TERMINAL +B OF ECM - BATTERY POSITIVE TERMINAL)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
506
05-317
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05IRG-02
EVAP INSPECTION PROCEDURE
DTCS RELATING TO EVAP SYSTEM
DTCs
Monitoring Items
See Page
P043E
0.02 inch orifice clogged (built into pump module)
05-190
P043F
0.02 inch orifice high-flow (built into pump module)
05-190
P0441
Purge VSV (Vacuum Switching Valve) stuck closed
Purge VSV stuck open
Purge flow
05-196
P0450
Pressure sensor (built into pump module) voltage abnormal fluctuation
05-202
P0451
Pressure sensor (built into pump module) noising
Pressure sensor stuck (built into pump module)
05-202
P0452
Pressure sensor (built into pump module) voltage low
05-202
P0453
Pressure sensor (built into pump module) voltage high
05-202
P0455
EVAP gross leak
05-211
P0456
EVAP small leak
05-211
P2401
Vacuum pump stuck OFF (built into pump module)
05-288
P2402
Vacuum pump stuck ON (built into pump module)
05-288
P2419
Vent valve stuck closed (built into pump module)
05-294
P2420
Vent valve stuck open (vent) (built into pump module)
05-294
P2610
Soak timer (built into ECM)
05-300
If any EVAP system DTCs are set, the malfunctioning area can be determined using the table below.
DTCs
Malfunctioning Areas
P043E
P043F
P0441
P0450
P0451
P0452
P0453
P0455
P0456
P2401
P2402
P2419
P2420
0.02 inch orifice clogged
0.02 inch orifice high-flow
Purge VSV stuck open
Purge VSV stuck closed
Pressure sensor stuck
Pressure sensor noise
Pressure sensor low output
Pressure sensor high output
Gross leak
Small leak
Vacuum pump stuck OFF
Vacuum pump stuck ON
Vent valve stuck closed
Vent valve stuck open (vent)
NOTICE:
If the 0.02 inch reference pressure difference between the first and second checks is greater than
the specification, the DTCs corresponding to the reference pressure (P043E, P043F, P0441, P0455,
P0456, P2401, P2420) will be all stored.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
507
05-318
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Location of EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system:
Pump Module
Pressure Sensor
Vacuum Pump
Canister
EVAP Hose
(To Throttle Body)
Vent Valve
Air Filter
Purge Line
Refueling Valve
EVAP Hose
(From Canister)
Purge VSV
Fuel Tank
Fuel Cap
A93865
EVAP System Circuit
Air Cleaner
Throttle Valve
ECM
Soak Timer
Intake Manifold
Purge VSV
Pump Module (refer to fig. 1)
Fuel Cap
Air Filter
Canister
Refueling Valve
Service Port
Restrictor (0.08 inch)
Roll-over Valve
Cut-of f Valve
Fuel Tank
A93866
While the engine is running, if a predetermined condition (closed-loop, etc.) is met, the purge VSV is opened
by the ECM and stored fuel vapors in the canister are purged to the intake manifold. The ECM changes the
duty cycle ratio of the purge VSV to control purge flow volume.
The purge flow volume is also determined by the intake manifold pressure. Atmospheric pressure is allowed
into the canister through the vent valve to ensure that the purge flow is maintained when the negative pressure (vacuum) is applied to the canister.
The following two monitors run to confirm appropriate EVAP system operation.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
508
05-319
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Key-off monitor
This monitor checks for EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system leaks and pump module malfunctions. The
monitor starts 5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned OFF. More than 5 hours are required to allow enough
time for the fuel to cool down to stabilize the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP), thus making the EVAP system monitor more accurate.
The electric vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and the pressure is
measured. Finally, the ECM monitors for leaks from the EVAP system, and malfunctions in both the pump
module and purge VSV, based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*:If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35C 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned off, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35C 7 hours after the ignition switch is turned off, the
monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Purge flow monitor
The purge flow monitor consists of the two monitors. The 1st monitor is always conducted every time and
the 2nd monitor is activated if necessary.
The 1st monitor
While the engine is running and the purge VSV (Vacuum Switching Valve) is ON (open), the ECM
monitors the purge flow by measuring the EVAP pressure change. If negative pressure is not
created, the ECM begins the 2nd monitor.
The 2nd monitor
The vent valve is turned ON (closed) and the EVAP pressure is then measured. If the variation
in the pressure is less than 0.5 kpa (3.75 mmHg), the ECM interprets this as the purge VSV being
stuck closed, and illuminates the MIL and sets DTC P0441 (2 trip detection logic).
Atmospheric pressure check:
In order to ensure reliable malfunction detection, the variation between the atmospheric pressures, before
and after conduction of the purge flow monitor, is measured by the ECM.
EVAP Purge Flow:
fuel tank cap
Refueling Valve
To Atmosphere
Purge VSV
(ON)
Fuel Tank
0.02 Inch Orifice
Canister
Pressure Sensor
To Intake Manifold
Air Filter
ECM
Vent Valve (OFF)
Vacuum Pump (OFF)
Pump Module
Soak Timer
A97610
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
509
05-320
DIAGNOSTICS
Components
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Operations
Canister
Contains activated charcoal to absorb EVAP (Evaporative Emissions) generated in fuel tank.
Cut-of f valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve floats and closes when fuel tank is 100 % full.
Purge VSV (Vacuum
Switching Valve)
Opens or closes line between canister and intake manifold. ECM uses purge VSV to control EVAP purge flow. In order
to discharge EVAP absorbed by canister to intake manifold, ECM opens purge VSV. EVAP discharge volume to intake
manifold controlled by purge VSV duty cycle ratio (current-carrying time). (Open: ON, Close: OFF)
Refueling valve
Controls EVAP pressure from fuel tank to canister. Valve consists of diaphragm, spring and restrictor (diameter: 0.08
inch). When fuel vapor and pressure inside fuel tank increase, valve opens. While EVAP purged, valve closes and restrictor prevents large amount of vacuum from affecting pressure in fuel tank. Valve opened while refueling. When valve
open, adding fuel into fuel tank possible.
Roll-over valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve closes by its own weight when vehicle overturns to prevent fuel from spilling out.
Service port
Used for connecting vacuum gauge for inspecting EVAP system.
Soak timer
Built into ECM. To ensure accurate EVAP monitor, measures 5 hours* after ignition switch turned to OFF. This allows
fuel to cool down, stabilizing Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP). When apprx. 5 hours* elapsed, ECM activates.
Pump module
Consists of (a) to (d) below. Pump module cannot be disassembled.
(a) Vent valve
Vents and closes EVAP system. When ECM turns valve ON, EVAP system closed. When, ECM turns valve OFF, EVAP
system vented. Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system to check for EVAP leaks by closing purge VSV,
turning on vent valve (closed) and operating vacuum pump (refer to fig. 1).
(b) Pressure sensor
Indicates pressure as voltages. ECM supplies regulated 5 V to pressure sensor, and uses feedback from sensor to
monitor EVAP system pressure (refer to fig 2).
(c) Vacuum pump
Creates negative pressure (vacuum) in EVAP system for leak check.
(d) 0.02 inch orifice
Has opening with 0.02 inch diameter. Vacuum produced through orifice by closing purge VSV, turning off vent valve and
operating vacuum pump, to monitor 0.02 inch leak pressure. 0.02 inch leak pressure indicates small leak of EVAP.
HINT:
*:If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35C after 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned off, the
monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35C 7 hours after the ignition switch is turned off,
the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
510
05-321
DIAGNOSTICS
Pump Module (fig. 1)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
: Airflow
Condition: Leak Check
Condition: Purge Flow
Vent Valve: OFF
(vent)
Vent Valve: ON
(closed)
To Air Filter
(Atmosphere)
Canister
0.02 Inch Orifice
Pressure Sensor
From Refueling Valve
Vacuum Pump: ON
Vacuum Pump: OFF
A97611
Pressure Sensor Specification (fig. 2)
Malfunction Area
Soak Timer Circuit (fig. 3)
Ignition Switch
Output Voltage
ECM
IGSW
4.900 V
EFI MAIN
+B
Power
Source IC
MREL
Main Relay
Control IC
15 A
4.150 V
Usable Range
Battery
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
Soak Timer IC
0.450 V
60
kPa
110
kPa
Pressure
HINT:
Standard atmospheric pressure is 101.3 kPa
A71562
A85251
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
511
05-322
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
C17
Pump Module
Pressure Sensor
ECM
16
BJ1
4
L
12
BJ1
3
Y
BR
Vacuum Pump
1
W
8
B
W-B
Y
17
BJ1 BR
13
BJ1
W
14
BJ1
R
18
BJ1
V
2
6
L
Vent Valve
9
R
7
IO1
P
15
IO1
BR
BJ1 15
12
IM1
16
IO1
SB
GR
5
IM1
1
2I
W
FL MAIN
A
Battery
BR
B-R
28
E2
E7
4
MPMP
E5
27
VPMP
E5
Y-G
1
G
34
PRG
E7
B
8
MREL
E5
2
V4
Purge VSV
B-R
2
BF
5
S29
LG
14
IM1
5V
Engine Room J/B
EFI No. 2
W-B
J19
J/C
5
S28
BR
VC
21
PPMP
E5
L
4
IO1
5
IO1
18
E7
Y
3
IO1
1
EB1
B-R
13
IM1
2
EFI No. 1
4
2F
W-B
A
EFI Relay
5
3
3
2D
2
1
5
2B
Y
P-L
13
IK3
J2
J/C
EH
A85256
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
512
05-323
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
A hand-held tester is required to conduct the following diagnostic troubleshooting procedure.
HINT:
Using hand-held tester monitor results enables the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system to be confirmed.
Read freeze frame data using a hand-held tester Freeze frame data record the engine condition when
malfunctions are detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle
was moving or stationary, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and
other data, from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CONFIRM DTC
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait 10 seconds.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait 10 seconds.
(d) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(e) Turn the ignition switch ON and press the hand-held tester switch ON.
(f)
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS/ ENHANCED OBD II/ DTC INFO/ CURRENT CODES.
(g) Confirm the DTCs and freeze frame data.
If any EVAP system DTCs are set, the malfunctioning area can be determined using the table below.
DTCs
Malfunctioning Areas
P043E
P043F
P0441
P0450
P0451
P0452
P0453
P0455
P0456
P2401
P2402
P2419
P2420
0.02 inch orifice clogged
0.02 inch orifice high-flow
Purge VSV stuck open
Purge VSV stuck closed
Pressure sensor stuck
Pressure sensor noise
Pressure sensor low output
Pressure sensor high output
Gross leak
Small leak
Vacuum pump stuck OFF
Vacuum pump stuck ON
Vent valve stuck closed
Vent valve stuck open (vent)
NOTICE:
If the 0.02 inch reference pressure difference between the first and second checks is greater than
the specification, the DTCs corresponding to the reference pressure (P043E, P043F, P0441, P0455,
P0456, P2401, P2420) will be all stored.
NEXT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
513
05-324
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK(AUTO OPERATION)
NOTICE:
In the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (AUTO OPERATION), the series of 5 EVAP SYSTEM CHECK steps
is performed automatically. It takes a maximum of approximately 18 minutes.
Do not perform the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK when the fuel tank is more than 90% full because
the cut-off valve may be closed and making the leak check of the fuel tank unavailable.
Do not run the engine in this step.
When the temperature of the fuel is 35C (95F) or more, a large amount of vapor forms and any
check results become inaccurate. When performing the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK, keep the temperature below 35C (95F).
(a) Clear DTCs (see page 05-38 ).
(b) On the hand-held tester, select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO OPERATION.
(c) After the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK is completed, check for pending DTCs by selecting the following
menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is displayed, perform the Monitor Confirmation after this repair is completed. After this
confirmation, check for pending DTCs. If no DTC is displayed, the EVAP system is normal.
NEXT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
514
05-325
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK(MANUAL OPERATION)
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Gross Leak
Negative
Second 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard x 0.2
Small Leak
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Steps
Time
(Reference)
No Leak
1/5
10
sec
Normal Pressure
5/5
4/5
2/5
3/5
60
sec
Within 15 minutes
10
sec
60
sec
G36782
NOTICE:
In the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (MANUAL OPERATION), the series of 5 EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
steps is performed manually.
Do not perform the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK when the fuel tank is more than 90% full because
the cut-off valve may be closed and making the leak check of the fuel tank unavailable.
Do not run the engine in this step.
When the temperature of the fuel is 35C (95F) or more, a large amount of vapor forms and any
check results become inaccurate. When performing the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK, keep the temperature below 35C (95F).
(a) Clear DTCs (see page 05-38 ).
(b) On the hand-held tester, select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / MANUAL OPERATION.
NEXT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
515
05-326
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK(STEP 1/5)
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
Pressure Sensor Noising
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
OK
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Steps
Time
(Reference)
1/5
10
sec
G36783
(a)
Check the EVAP pressure in step 1/5.
Result:
DTCs*
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Virtually no variation in EVAP pressure
Not yet determined
A
P0451
EVAP pressure fluctuates by 0.3 kPa
(2.25 mmHg) or more
Pressure sensor noising
B
*: The DTCs relating to the EVAP system displayed on a hand-held tester when checking.
B
Go to step 30
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
516
05-327
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK(STEP 1/5 TO 2/5)
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
Vacuum Pump Stuck ON
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Steps
Time
(Reference)
1/5
2/5
10
sec
60
sec
G36784
(a)
Check the EVAP pressure in step 1/5 and 2/5.
Result:
DTCs*
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Virtually no variation in EVAP pressure during step
1/5. Then decreases to 0.02 inch leak pressure
standard*
Not yet determined
A
P2402
Small difference between EVAP pressures during
steps 1/5 and 2/5
Vacuum pump stuck ON
B
*: The DTCs relating to the EVAP system displayed on a hand-held tester when checking.
HINT:
The first 0.02 inch leak pressure standard is the value determined in step 2/5.
B
Go to step 23
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
517
05-328
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK(STEP 2/5)
ON
Vent Valve
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
Vacuum Pump Stuck OFF
0.02 inch Orifice High-flow
4 sec
Positive
Vent Valve Stuck closed
Negative
OK
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
0.02 inch Orifice Clogged
Steps
Time
(Reference)
2/5
3/5
60
sec
Within 15 minutes
G36785
HINT:
Make a note of the pressures checked in steps (a) and (b) below.
(a) Check the EVAP pressure 4 seconds after the vacuum pump is activated*.
(b) Check the EVAP pressure again when it has stabilized. This pressure is the 0.02 inch leak pressure
standard.
*: The vacuum pump begins to operate as step 1/5 is proceeded to step 2/5.
Result:
DTCs*
Test Results
EVAP pressure in step (b) between -4.85 kPa
and -1.06 kPa (-36.38 mmHg and -7.95 mmHg)
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Not yet determined
A
P043F and P2401
EVAP pressure in step (b) -1.06 kPa (-7.95
mmHg) or more
0.02 inch orifice high-flow
Vacuum pump stuck OFF
B
P043E
EVAP pressure in step (b) below -4.85 kPa
(-36.38 mmHg)
0.02 inch orifice clogged
C
P2419
EVAP pressure in step (a) more than -1.06 kPa
(-7.95 mmHg)
Vent valve stuck closed
D
*: The DTCs relating to the EVAP system displayed on a hand-held tester when checking.
B
Go to step 11
C
Go to step 30
D
Go to step 19
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
518
05-329
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK(STEP 2/5 TO 3/5)
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ON
Vent Valve
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
Vent Valve Stuck open (vent)
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Steps
2/5
Time
(Reference)
3/5
Within 15 minutes
G36786
(a)
Check the EVAP pressure increase in step 3/5.
Result:
DTCs*
Test Results
EVAP pressure increases by 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
or more within 10 seconds of proceeding from step
2/5 to step 3/5
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Not yet determined
A
P2420
No variation in EVAP pressure despite proceeding
from step 2/5 to step 3/5
Vent valve stuck open (vent)
B
P0451
No variation in EVAP pressure during steps 1/5
through 3/5
Pressure sensor malfunction stuck
C
*: The DTCs relating to the EVAP system displayed on a hand-held tester when checking.
B
Go to step 20
C
Go to step 30
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
519
05-330
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK(STEP 3/5)
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Steps
Time
(Reference)
3/5
Within 15 minutes
G38126
(a) Wait until the EVAP pressure change is less than 0.1 kPa (0.75 mmHg) for 30 seconds.
(b) Measure the EVAP pressure and record it.
HINT:
A few minutes are required for the EVAP pressure to become saturated. When there is little fuel in the fuel
tank, it takes up to 15 minutes.
NEXT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
520
05-331
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK(STEP 4/5)
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ON
Vent Valve
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
OK
Positive
Negative
Puge VSV Stuck Closed
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Steps
4/5
Time
(Reference)
10
sec
G36776
(a)
Check the EVAP pressure in step 4/5.
DTCs*
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
EVAP pressure increases by 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
or more within 10 seconds of proceeding from step
3/5 to step 4/5
Not yet determined
A
P0441
EVAP pressure increases by 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
or more within 10 seconds of proceeding from step
3/5 to step 4/5
Problems in EVAP hose between pure VSV and
throttle body
B
P0441
Variation in EVAP pressure is less than 0.3 kPa
(2.25 mmHg) for 10 seconds, after proceeding from
step 3/5 to step 4/5
Purge VSV stuck closed
C
*: The DTCs relating to the EVAP system displayed on a hand-held tester when checking.
B
Go to step 15
C
Go to step 12
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
521
05-332
DIAGNOSTICS
10
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK(STEP 5/5)
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
Vent Valve
ON
Vacuum Pump
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
EVAP Pressure
Gross Leak
Positive
Negative
Second 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard x 0.2
Small Leak
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
No Leak
Steps
5/5
60
sec
Time
(Reference)
G36782
(a)
(b)
Check the EVAP pressure in step 5/5.
Compare the EVAP pressure in step 3/5 and the second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard (step 5/5).
Result:
DTCs*
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
EVAP pressure (step 3/5) lower than the second
0.02 inch leak pressure standard (step 5/5)
Not yet determined (no leakage from EVAP system)
A
P0441 and
P0455
EVAP pressure (step 3/5) higher than [second 0.02
inch leak pressure standard (step 5/5) x 0.2]
Purge VSV stuck open
EVAP gross leak
B
P0456
EVAP pressure (step 3/5) higher than second 0.02
inch leak pressure standard (step 5/5)
EVAP small leak
B
Test Results
*: The DTCs relating to the EVAP system displayed on a hand-held tester when checking.
A
Go to step 36
B
Go to step 12
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
522
05-333
DIAGNOSTICS
11
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK(STEP 3/5)
ON
Vent Valve
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
Vacuum Pump Stuck OFF
Positive
Negative
0.02 inch Oriffice High-flow
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Steps
2/5
3/5
Time
(Reference)
Within 15 minutes
G36788
(a)
Check the EVAP pressure in step 3/5.
Result:
DTCs*
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
P043F and
P2401
EVAP pressure less than [0.02 inch leak pressure
standard x 0.2]
0.02 inch orifice high-flow
A
P043F and
P2401
EVAP pressure more than [0.02 inch leak pressure
standard x 0.2]
Vacuum pump stuck OFF
B
*: The DTCs relating to the EVAP system displayed on a hand-held tester when checking.
HINT:
The 0.02 inch leak pressure standard is the value determined in step 2/5.
A
Go to step 30
B
Go to step 23
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
523
05-334
DIAGNOSTICS
12
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST(PURGE VSV)
(a)
On the hand-held tester, select the following menu items:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II/ ACTIVE TEST /
EVAP VSV.
Disconnect the hose (connected to the canister) from the
purge VSV.
Start the engine.
On the tester, turn off the purge VSV (EVAP VSV: OFF).
Use your finger to confirm that the purge VSV has no suction.
Using the tester, turn on the purge VSV (EVAP VSV: ON).
Use your finger to confirm that the purge VSV has suction.
(b)
Purge VSV
Hose (to canister)
(c)
(d)
(e)
A85254
(f)
(g)
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
No suction when purge VSV turned OFF, and suction applied
when tuned ON
Purge VSV normal
A
Suction applied when purge VSV turned OFF
Purge VSV stuck open
B
No suction when purge VSV turned ON
Purge VSV stuck closed
Problems with EVAP hose between purge VSV and throttle
body
C
(h)
Reconnect the hose.
B
Go to step 14
C
Go to step 15
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
524
05-335
DIAGNOSTICS
13
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK FUEL TANK CAP ASSY
(a) Check that the fuel tank cap is correctly installed.
(b) Confirm that the fuel tank cap is tightened until a few click sounds are heard.
HINT:
If an EVAP tester is available, check the fuel tank cap using the tester.
(1) Remove the fuel tank cap and install it onto a fuel tank cap adaptor.
(2) Connect an EVAP tester pump hose to the adaptor, and pressurize to 3.2 to 3.7 kPa (24 to 28
mmHg) using an EVAP tester pump.
(3) Seal the adaptor and wait for 2 minutes.
(4) Check the pressure. If the pressure is 2 kPa (15 mmHg) or more, the fuel tank cap is normal.
(5) Reinstall the fuel tank cap.
Result:
Test Results
Suspected trouble Areas
Proceed To
A
Fuel tank cap correctly installed
Fuel tank cap improperly installed
Defective fuel tank cap
Fuel tank cap does not meet OEM specifications
Fuel tank cap loose
No fuel tank cap
14
B
A
Go to step 29
B
Go to step 27
C
Go to step 28
C
INSPECT VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE ASSY NO.1
(a)
(b)
(c)
Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
Disconnect the purge VSV connector.
Disconnect the hose (connected to the canister) from the
purge VSV.
Start the engine.
Use your finger to confirm that the purge VSV has no suction.
(d)
(e)
Purge VSV
Hose (to canister)
A85254
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
No suction
ECM
A
Suction applied
Purge VSV
B
(f)
(g)
Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
Reconnect the hose.
A
Go to step 35
B
Go to step 31
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
525
05-336
DIAGNOSTICS
15
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK EVAP HOSE(PURGE VSV - THROTTLE BODY)
(a)
Hose (to throtlle body)
Disconnect the hose (connected to the throttle body) from
the purge VSV.
Start the engine.
Use your finger to confirm that the hose has suction.
(b)
(c)
Purge VSV
A85261
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Suction applied
EVAP hose between purge VSV and throttle body
normal
A
No suction
Throttle body
EVAP hose between purge VSV and throttle
body
B
(d)
Reconnect the hose.
B
Go to step 26
A
16
NSPECT VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE ASSY NO.1(PURGE VSV)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Purge VSV
Remove the purge VSV.
Apply battery voltage to the terminals of the purge VSV.
Using an air gun, confirm that air flows from port A to port
B.
A
B
A68357
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Air flowed
Purge VSV normal
A
No air flow
Purge VSV
B
(d)
Install the purge VSV.
B
Go to step 31
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
526
05-337
DIAGNOSTICS
17
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(POWER SOURCE OF PURGE VSV)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
V4
Purge VSV
Disconnect the V4 Purge VSV connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage between terminal 1 of the V4 connector and the body ground.
A56870
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Between 11 V and 14 V
Normal
A
Other than result above
Wire harness or connectors between purge VSV
and ECM
B
(d)
Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
B
Go to step 32
A
18
CHECK WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PURGE VSV - ECM)
(a)
Disconnect the E7 connector and the V4 purge VSV connector.
(b) Check the resistance.
Standard:
ECM
E7
Tester Connections
34 (PRG)
A81699
Specified Conditions
E7-34 (PRG) - V1-1
Below 1 Ω
E7-34 (PRG) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
V4-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(c)
(d)
Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
Reconnect the ECM connector.
Wire Harness Side
V4
Purge VSV
A56870
OK
Go to step 35
NG
Go to step 32
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
527
05-338
DIAGNOSTICS
19
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER(FOR VENT VALVE)
(a)
(b)
ECM
Turn the ignition switch to ON.
On the hand-held tester, select the following menu items:
DIAGNOSIS/ ENHANCED OBD II/ ACTIVE TEST/ VENT
VALVE (ALONE).
Measure the voltage between terminal VPMP of the ECM
connector and the body ground when the vent valve is
turned ON (close) and OFF (vent) using the tester.
E5
(c)
27 (VPMP)
A85259
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Between 9 V and 14 V when OFF
Below 3 V when ON
Vent valve
A
Below 3 V when OFF and ON
ECM
B
20
A
Go to step 22
B
Go to step 35
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER(FOR VENT VALVE)
(a)
(b)
ECM
Turn the ignition switch to ON.
On the hand-held tester, select the following menu items:
DIAGNOSIS/ ENHANCED OBD II/ ACTIVE TEST/ VENT
VALVE (ALONE).
Measure the voltage between terminal VPMP of the ECM
connector and the body ground when the vent valve is
turned ON (close) and OFF (vent) using the tester.
E5
(c)
27 (VPMP)
A85259
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Below 3 V when OFF and ON
Power source of vent valve
A
Between 9 V and 14 V when OFF
Below 3 V when ON
Vent valve
B
Between 9 V and 14 V when OFF and ON
ECM
C
B
Go to step 22
C
Go to step 35
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
528
05-339
DIAGNOSTICS
21
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT PUMP MODULE(POWER SOURCE FOR VENT VALVE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Disconnect the C17 canister connector.
Turn the ignition switch to ON.
Measure the voltage between terminal 9 of the canister
connector and the body ground.
C17
A85252
Wire Harness Side
C17
Canister
A85258
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Between 9 V and 14 V
Normal
A
Between 0 V and 3 V
Power source wire harness of vent valve
B
(e)
Reconnect the canister connector.
B
Go to step 32
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
529
05-340
DIAGNOSTICS
22
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT PUMP MODULE(VENT VALVE OPERATION)
(a)
(b)
(c)
9 (+)
8 (-)
Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
Disconnect the canister connector.
Apply the battery voltage to terminals 9 and 8 of the pump
module.
Touch the pump module to confirm the vent valve operation.
(d)
A85253
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Operating
Wire harness between vent valve and ECM
A
Not operating
Vent valve
B
(e)
23
Reconnect the canister connector.
A
Go to step 32
B
Go to step 30
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER(FOR PUMP
MODULE(VACUUM PUMP)
(a)
ECM
On the hand-held tester, select the following menu items:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VACUUM PUMP (ALONE).
Measure the voltage between terminal MPMP of the ECM
connector and the body ground when the vacuum pump
is turned ON and OFF using the tester.
E5
(b)
4 (MPMP)
A85259
Result:
Tests Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Between 0 V and 3 V when OFF
Between 9 V and 14 V when ON
ECM normal
A
Between 9 V and 14 V when OFF
Between 0 V and 3 V when ON
ECM
B
B
Go to step 35
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
530
05-341
DIAGNOSTICS
24
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Disconnect the C17 canister connector.
Turn the ignition switch to ON.
On the hand- held tester, select the following menu
items:DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST
/ VACUUM PUMP (ALONE).
Turn the vacuum pump ON.
Measure the voltage between terminal 1 of the canister
connector and the body ground.
(e)
(f)
C17
A85252
Wire Harness Side
C17
Canister
A85258
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Between 9 V and 14 V
Normal
A
Between 0 V and 3 V
Wire harness between ECM and vacuum pump
B
(g)
Reconnect the canister connector.
B
Go to step 32
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
531
05-342
DIAGNOSTICS
25
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PUMP MODULE - GROUND)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
Disconnect the C17 canister connector.
Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
Check the resistance between terminal 6 of the canister
connector and the body ground.
C17
Canister
A85258
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Below 1 Ω
Vacuum pump
A
10 kΩ or more
Wire harness between vacuum pump and body
ground
B
(d)
26
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Reconnect the canister connector.
A
Go to step 30
B
Go to step 32
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY ASSY
Stop the engine.
Disconnect the EVAP hose from the throttle body.
Start the engine.
Use your finger to confirm that the port of the throttle body has suction.
Result:
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Suction applied
Test Results
EVAP hose between throttle body and purge VSV
A
No suction
Throttle body
B
(e)
27
Reconnect the EVAP hose.
A
Go to step 33
B
Go to step 34
CORRECTLY REINSTALL OR REPLACE FUEL TANK CAP
HINT:
When reinstalling the fuel tank cap, tighten it until a few click sounds are heard.
When replacing the fuel tank cap, use a fuel tank cap that meets OEM specifications, and tighten it
until a few click sounds are heard.
NEXT
Go to step 37
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
532
05-343
DIAGNOSTICS
28
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
REPLACE FUEL TANK CAP ASSY
HINT:
When installing the fuel tank cap, tighten it until a few click sounds are heard.
NEXT
29
Go to step 37
REPAIR EVAP LEAK PART
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Reinstall the fuel cap.
Remove the exhaust tail pipe.
Remove the heat insulator under the canister.
Pinch the atmospheric side hose of the pump module with
the clip to close the canister’s passage to air.
A85255
(e)
Pressure Gauge
Pressure
B06546
Connect the pressure gauge (SST) to the service port
(green cap near the air cleaner box).
(f)
Pressurize the EVAP system to 3.2 to 3.7 kPa (24 to 28
mmHg).
NOTICE:
More than 35 mmHg of pressure will damage the EVAP system. Pay attention to the pressure.
(g) Apply soapy water to the piping and connecting parts of
the EVAP system. Look for the area where bubbles appear. This area cause leaks.
HINT:
If the system has leaks, a whistling sound will be heard.
Disconnect the hose between canister and fuel tank from
the canister. Close the canister on the area where the
hose was connected and perform an inspection. The fuel
tank can be eliminated from the suspected areas for leak
checks.
(h) Repair or replace the leak point.
NEXT
30
Go to step 37
REPLACE CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY
NEXT
Go to step 37
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
533
05-344
DIAGNOSTICS
31
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
REPLACE VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE ASSY NO.1(PURGE VSV)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the connector and the hoses from the purge
VSV.
Remove the purge VSV.
Install a new purge VSV.
Reconnect the connector and hoses.
Purge VSV
A85254
32
NEXT
Go to step 37
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
In case that the exhaust tail pipe is removed, go to the next step before installing it.
NEXT
33
REPLACE EVAP HOSE(THROTTLE BODY - PURGE VSV)
NEXT
34
(a)
(b)
Remove the throttle body (see page 10-6 ).
Check that there is no clog in the EVAP purge port of the throttle body. If necessary, replace the throttle
body.
(a)
Go to step 37
REPLACE ECM (see page 10-9 )
NEXT
36
Go to step 37
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY ASSY
NEXT
35
Go to step 37
Go to step 37
REPAIR OR REPLACE PARTS AND COMPONENTS INDICATED BY OUTPUT DTCS
Repair the malfunctioning areas indicated by the DTCs that had been confirmed when the vehicle was
brought in.
NEXT
Go to step 37
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
534
05-345
DIAGNOSTICS
37
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK(AUTO OPERATION)
NOTICE:
In the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK (AUTO OPERATION), the series of 5 EVAP SYSTEM CHECK steps
is performed automatically. It takes a maximum of approximately 18 minutes.
Do not perform the EVAP SYSTEM CHECK when the fuel tank is more than 90% full because
the cut-off valve may be closed, making the leak check of the fuel tank unavailable.
Do not run the engine in this step.
When the temperature of the fuel is 35C (95F) or more, a large amount of vapor forms and any
check results become inaccurate. When performing an EVAP SYSTEM CHECK, keep the temperature below 35C (95F).
(a) Clear DTCs (see page 05-38 ).
(b) On the hand-held tester, select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO OPERATION.
(c) After the SYSTEM CHECK is completed, check for pending DTCs by selecting the following menu
items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is found, the repair has been successfully completed.
NEXT
COMPLETED
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
535
05-346
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Monitor Confirmation
HINT:
After a repair, check Monitor Status by performing the Key-Off Monitor Confirmation and Purge Flow Monitor
Confirmation described below.
1.
KEY-OFF MONITOR CONFIRMATION
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
The vehicle has been driven for 10 minutes or more (in a city area or on a free way)
The fuel tank is less than 90% full
The altitude is less than 8,000 ft (2,400 m)
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is between 4.4C and 35C (40F and 95F)
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) is between 4.4C and 35C (40F and 95F)
The vehicle remains stationary (the vehicle speed is 0 mph [0 km/h])
(b) Monitor Conditions
(1) Allow the engine to idle for at least 5 minutes.
(2) Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for 6 hours (8 or 10.5 hours).
HINT:
Do not start the engine until checking MONITOR STATUS. If the engine is started, the steps described above
must be repeated.
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Connect a hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the tester ON.
(3) On the tester, select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR
STATUS.
(4) Check the Monitor Status displayed on the tester.
HINT:
If INCMP is displayed, the monitor is not completed. Make sure that the preconditions have been met, and
perform the Monitor Conditions again.
2.
PURGE FLOW MONITOR CONFIRMATION (P0441)
HINT:
Perform this monitor confirmation after the Key-Off Monitor Confirmation shows COMPL (complete).
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
The vehicle has been driven for 10 minutes or more (in a city area or on a free way)
The ECT is between 4.4C and 35C (40F and 95F)
The IAT is between 4.4C and 35C (40F and 95F)
(b) Monitor Conditions
(1) Release the pressure from the fuel tank by removing and reinstalling the fuel tank cap.
(2) Warm the engine up until the ECT reaches more than 75C (167F).
(3) Increase the engine speed to 3,000 rpm once.
(4) Allow the engine to idle and turn A/C ON for 1 minute.
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Turn the ignition switch OFF (where ON or the engine is running).
(2) Connect a hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(3) Turn the ignition switch to ON and turn the tester ON.
(4) On the tester, select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR
STATUS.
(5) Check the Monitor Status displayed on the tester.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
536
05-347
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
HINT:
If INCMP is displayed, the monitor is not completed. Make sure that the preconditions have been met, and
perform the Monitor Conditions again.
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-26 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (Refer to ”Confirmation Monitor”).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
(d) Key - off
TID $02: EVAP system (Key-off monitor)
TLT
CID
Unit Conversion
Description of Test Data
Description of Test Limit
1
$01
Multiplied by 0.0156 subtract 2
(kPa)
Test value for small leak (P0456):
Refer to pressure D*
Malfunction criteria (0 kPa)
1
$02
Multiplied by 0.0156 subtract 2
(kPa)
Test value for gross leak (P0455):
Refer to pressure E*
Malfunction criteria (0 kPa)
1
$03
Multiplied by 0.0156 subtract 2
(kPa)
Test value for vacuum pump stuck OFF
(P2401):
Refer to pressure A*
Malfunction criteria (0 kPa)
1
$04
Multiplied by 0.0156 subtract 2
(kPa)
Test value for vacuum pump stuck ON
(P2402):
Refer to pressure A*
Malfunction criteria (0 kPa)
1
$05
Multiplied by 0.0156 subtract 2
(kPa)
Test value for vent valve stuck OFF (vent)
(P2420):
Refer to pressure C*
Malfunction criteria (0 kPa)
1
$06
Multiplied by 0.0156 subtract 2
(kPa)
Test value for vent valve stuck ON (closed)
(P2419):
Refer to pressure A*
Malfunction criteria (0 kPa)
1
$07
Multiplied by 0.0156 subtract 2
(kPa)
Test value for 0.02 inch orifice low flow
(P043E):
Refer to pressure B*
Malfunction criteria (0 kPa)
1
$08
Multiplied by 0.0156 subtract 2
(kPa)
Test value for 0.02 inch orifice high flow
(P043F):
Refer to pressure A*
Malfunction criteria (0 kPa)
1
$11
Multiplied by 0.0156 subtract 2
(kPa)
Test value for purge VSV stuck close
(P0441):
Refer to pressure F*
Malfunction criteria (0 kPa)
1
$12
Multiplied by 0.0156 subtract 2
(kPa)
Test value for purge VSV stuck open
(P0441):
Refer to pressure E*
Malfunction criteria (0 kPa)
1
$13
Multiplied by 0.0156 subtract 2
(kPa)
Test value for purge flow (P0441):
Refer to pressure G*
Malfunction criteria (0 kPa)
* Pressures A to G are indicated as shown in the diagram below.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
537
05-348
DIAGNOSTICS
Key-off Monitor
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Monitor Start
ON (Open)
Purge VSV
ON (Close)
Vent Valve
ON
Pump
EVAP Pressure
(Reference)
Atomosphere (0 kPa)
Criterion 2 (Criterion 4 x 0.2)
Criterion 1 (-1.2 kPa)
A
C
Criterion 3 (0.3 kPa)
F
E
B
Criterion 5 (-4.3 kPa)
Elapsed Time (Seconds)
Criterion 4
D
Criterion 6 (0.3 kPa)
4
60
10
Within 720
10
60
Purge Flow Monitor
Sequence
2
1
ON (Open)
Purge VSV
ON (Close)
If pressure change in sequence 1 is
greater than criterion 7, purge flow monitor is completed (functioning normally).
Vent Valve
EVAP Pressure
(Reference)
If pressure change in sequence 1 is
smaller than criterion 7, sequence 2 is
run.
Criterion 7 (0.1 kPa)
Criterion 8 (1kPa)
G
If pressure change in sequence 2 is
smaller than criterion 8, purge flow is insufficient.
G38136
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
538
05-42
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ESR-05
FAIL-SAFE CHART
If any of the following codes are recorded, the ECM enters fail-safe mode.
DTC No.
Fail-Safe Operation
Fail-Safe Deactivation Conditions
P0031
P0032
P0037
P0038
Turn off heater
Ignition switch OFF
P0100
P0102
P0103
Ignition timing is calculated from engine speed and throttle
angle
”Pass” condition detected
P0110
P0112
P0113
Intake air temperature is fixed at 20°C (68°F)
”Pass” condition detected
P0115
P0116
P0117
P0118
Engine coolant temperature is fixed at 80°C (176°F)
”Pass” condition detected
P0120
P0121
P0122
P0123
P0220
P0222
P0223
P0604
P0606
P0607
P0657
P2102
P2103
P2111
P2112
P2118
P2119
P2135
If Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has malfunction, ECM cuts off current to throttle control motor. Throttle
control valve returns to predetermined opening angle
(approximately 16) by force of return spring. ECM then
adjusts engine output by controlling fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with accelerator pedal opening angle to enable vehicle to continue at
minimal speed.
If accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, vehicle
can be driven slowly. If accelerator pedal is depressed
quickly, vehicle may speed up and slow down erratically.
”Pass” condition is detected and then ignition switch is turned
OFF, fail-safe operation will stop and system will return to
normal condition
P0325
P0327
P0328
Maximum timing retardation
Ignition switch OFF
P0351
P0352
P0353
P0354
Fuel is cut
”Pass” condition detected
P2120
P2121
P2122
P2123
P2125
P2127
P2128
P2138
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two (main and sub)
sensor circuits. If malfunction occurs in either of sensor
circuits, ECM detects abnormal signal voltage difference
between two sensor circuits and switches to limp mode. In
limp mode, remaining circuit is used to calculate accelerator
pedal opening to allow vehicle to continue driving.
If both circuits malfunction, ECM regards opening angle of
accelerator pedal to be fully closed. In this case, throttle
valve will remain closed as if engine is idling.
”Pass” condition is detected and then ignition switch is turned
OFF, fail-safe operation will stop and system will return to
normal condition
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
232
05-349
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EW0-05
FUEL PUMP CONTROL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the engine is cranked, current flows from the ignition switch terminal ST1 to the starter relay coil (Marking: STARTER), and current flows to terminal STA of the ECM (STA signal).
When the STA signal and NE signal are input to the ECM, Tr is turned ON, current flows to coil of the circuit
opening relay, (Marking) the relay switches on, power is supplied to the fuel pump and the fuel pump operates.
While the NE signal is generated and the engine is running, the ECM keeps Tr ON (Circuit Opening relay
ON) and the fuel pump also keeps operating.
Circuit Opening Relay
EFI Relay
ECM
Fuel Pump
EFI NO. 1
FC
Tr
MREL
Ignition Switch
STARTER
AM2
AM1
AM1
ST1
AM2
IG2
ST2
IGN
IGSW
PNP Switch
ALT
(STA Signal)
STA
(NE Signal)
NE
STARTER
Relay
Main
Battery
Starter
A90307
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
539
05-350
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Passenger Side J/B
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
1
GR
6
IGN
1C
W
1G
4
1
4M
4F
ECM
W
13
P-L
I15
Ignition Switch
6
IG2
AM2
8
Y
2B
1
5 2B
EFI
Relay
1
1
1
5
Circuit
Opening
Relay
IC1
5
2
F7
10 FL Block Assy
2
3
EFI
NO. 1
L-Y
1
2I
4
2F
1
W
1
BR
AM2
3
MREL
R/B No.1
3
1
E5
B
IC2
Engine
Room J/B
7
1
IK3
2
W
8
B
W-B
8
IA2
10
Y
A
W
J2
J/C
FL
Main
EH
FC
4
F12
Fuel Pump
5
Battery
E5
L
W-B
BC
A90308
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
540
05-351
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Hand-held tester:
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER (OPERATE CIRCUIT
OPENING RELAY)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn ON the ignition switch. Push the hand-held tester main switch.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / FUEL PUMP / SPD.
Check the relay operation while operating it with the hand-held tester.
OK: Operating noise can be heard from the relay.
OK
Go to step 5
NG
2
INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
2
1
3
1
5
(a)
(b)
5
2
Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B sub-assy.
Measure the resistance of the circuit opening relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (FC VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
(a)
(b)
FC (+)
E5
ECM
A67446
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-10 (FC) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
541
05-352
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY, CIRCUIT OPENING
RELAY - IGNITION SWITCH)
(a)
E5
ECM
FC
R/B Sub-assy
Check the wire harness between the ECM and circuit
opening relay.
(1) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(2) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-10 (FC) - R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 2
Below 1 Ω
E5-10 (FC) or
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Circuit Opening
Relay
A67445
A90342
A92641
(b)
Wire Harness Side
R/B Sub-assy
Circuit Opening
Relay
Instrument
Panel J/B
Assy
Check the wire harness between the circuit opening relay
and ignition switch.
(1) Check the IGN fuse.
Remove the IGN fuse from the instrument
panel J/B.
Measure the resistance of the IGN fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
Reinstall the IGN fuse.
(2) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(3) Disconnect the I15 ignition switch connector.
(4) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
IGN fuse
I15
Ignition Switch
1
5
A90342
A90344
A61075
IG2
2
6
3
7
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 1 - I15-6 (IG2)
Below 1 Ω
I15-6 (IG2) or
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
4
8
A92642
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
542
05-353
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
5
INSPECT FUEL PUMP ASSY
(a)
Measure the resistance of the fuel pump terminals.
Standard:
Tester Condition
Condition
Specified Condition
4-5
20C (68F)
0.2 to 0.3 Ω
3 2 1
5
(b)
4
F12
Fuel Pump
A74356
Check operation of the fuel pump.
(1) Apply battery voltage to both the terminals. Check
that the pump operates.
NOTICE:
These tests must be done quickly (within 10 seconds)
to prevent the coil from burning out.
Keep the fuel pump as far away from the battery as
possible.
Always turn ON and OFF the voltage on the battery
side, not the fuel pump side.
NG
REPLACE FUEL PUMP ASSY
(See page 11-16 )
OK
6
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY - FUEL PUMP, FUEL PUMP BODY GROUND)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
R/B Sub-assy
Circuit Opening Relay
F12
Fuel Pump
A90342
A67586
Check the wire harness between the circuit opening relay
and fuel pump.
(1) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(2) Disconnect the F12 fuel pump connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 3 - F12-4
Below 1 Ω
F12-4 or
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 3 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A92648
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
543
05-354
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
Wire Harness Side
F12
Fuel Pump
A67586
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Check the wire harness between the fuel pump and body
ground.
(1) Disconnect the F12 fuel pump connector.
(2) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector and body ground.
Standard:
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F12-5 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
CHECK FUEL PUMP OPERATION (See Page 11-4 )
(a) Check if there is pressure in the fuel inlet hose.
HINT:
The pipe has fuel pressure if the sound of flowing fuel can be heard.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN ON PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-31 )
NG
2
CHECK RELAY OPERATION (CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY)
(a)
E5
ECM
When connecting between terminal FC of the ECM connector and body ground, check relay operation.
OK: Noise can be heard from the circuit opening
relay.
FC
A53765
OK
Go to step 6
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
544
05-355
DIAGNOSTICS
3
1
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
2
1
3
-
5
(a)
(b)
5
2
Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B sub-assy.
Measure the resistance of the circuit opening relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3
NG
B60778
REPLACE CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
OK
4
INSPECT ECM (FC VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
(a)
(b)
FC (+)
E5
ECM
A67446
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-10 (FC) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
545
05-356
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY, CIRCUIT OPENING
RELAY - IGNITION SWITCH)
(a)
E5
ECM
FC
R/B Sub-assy
Check the wire harness between the ECM and circuit
opening relay.
(1) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(2) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-10 (FC) - R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 2
Below 1 Ω
E5-10 (FC) or
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Circuit Opening
Relay
A67445
A90342
A92641
(b)
Wire Harness Side
R/B Sub-assy
Circuit Opening
Relay
Instrument
Panel J/B
Assy
Check the wire harness between the circuit opening relay
and ignition switch.
(1) Check the IGN fuse.
Remove the IGN fuse from the instrument
panel J/B Assy.
Check the resistance of the IGN fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
Reinstall the IGN fuse.
(2) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(3) Disconnect the I15 ignition switch connector.
(4) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
IGN fuse
I15
Ignition Switch
1
5
A90342
A90344
A61075
2
6
3
7
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 1 - I15-6 (IG2)
Below 1 Ω
I15-6 (IG2) or
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
4
8
NG
IG2
A92642
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
546
05-357
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
6
INSPECT FUEL PUMP ASSY
(a)
Measure the resistance of the fuel pump terminals.
Standard:
Tester Condition
Condition
Specified Condition
4-5
20C (68F)
0.2 to 0.3 Ω
3 2 1
5
(b)
4
F12
Fuel Pump
A74356
Check operation of the fuel pump.
(1) Apply battery voltage to both the terminals. Check
that the pump operates.
NOTICE:
These tests must be done quickly (within 10 seconds)
to prevent the coil from burning out.
Keep the fuel pump as far away from the battery as
possible.
Always turns ON and OFF the voltage on the battery
side, not the fuel pump side.
NG
REPLACE FUEL PUMP ASSY
(See page 11-16 )
OK
7
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY - FUEL PUMP, FUEL PUMP BODY GROUND)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
R/B Sub-assy
Circuit Opening Relay
F12
Fuel Pump
A90342
A67586
Check the wire harness between the circuit opening relay
and fuel pump.
(1) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B SubAssy.
(2) Disconnect the F12 fuel pump connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 3 - F12-4
Below 1 Ω
F12-4 or
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 3 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A92648
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
547
05-358
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
Wire Harness Side
F12
Fuel Pump
A67586
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Check the wire harness between the fuel pump and body
ground.
(1) Disconnect the F12 fuel pump connector.
(2) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector and body ground.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F12-5 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
548
05-16
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ITB-02
LIST OF DISABLE A MONITOR
HINT:
The table below shows the ECM monitoring status for the components listed in the top of the table when
the DTCs on the left of the table are set.
A92556
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
206
05-17
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
A92557
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
207
05-18
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
A92558
Note *1: Without input speed sensor
Note *2: With input speed sensor
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
208
05-19
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
A92559
Note *1: Without input speed sensor
Note *2: With input speed sensor
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
209
05-20
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
A92560
Note *1: Without input speed sensor
Note *2: With input speed sensor
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
210
05-21
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
A92561
Note *1: Without input speed sensor
Note *2: With input speed sensor
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
211
05-359
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EW1-05
MIL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) is used to indicate the ECM’s detection of a vehicle malfunction.
The instrument panel IG2 fuse provides circuit power and the ECM provides the circuit ground that illuminates the MIL.
MIL operations should be checked visually:
The MIL should be illuminated when the ignition is first turned ON. If the MIL is always ON or OFF, use the
hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool and follow the procedures to determine the cause of problem.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Passenger Side J/B
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
GR
1
6
IGN
1C
W
1G
4
1
4M
4E
ECM
P
6
IG2
AM2
7
I15
Ignition
Switch
J6
J/C
9
IL1
P
E
E
Y
1
SB
IC1
Combination Meter
L-Y
13
C11
10
4
C12
L
11
10
IL2
SB
E5
W
MIL
AM2
F7
FL Block Assy
1
W
FL
Main
Battery
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
A90349
Author:
Date:
549
05-360
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Troubleshoot each trouble symptom in accordance with the chart below.
MIL remains on
Start inspection from step 1
MIL is not illuminated
Start inspection from step 3
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
CLEAR DTC
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
Read the DTC.
Clear the DTC (see page 05-38 ).
Check that the MIL is not illuminated.
OK: MIL is not illuminated
OK
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT DTC
(See page 05-48 )
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CHECK FOR SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
E5
ECM
(a)
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check that the MIL is not illuminated.
OK: MIL is not illuminated
W
A67445
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
3
(a)
CHECK THAT MIL IS ILLUMINATED
Check that the MIL is illuminated when turning the ignition switch ON.
OK: MIL is illuminated
NG
SYSTEM OK
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
550
05-361
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSY (MIL CIRCUIT)
See the combination meter troubleshooting on page 05-1889 .
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE BULB OR COMBINATION
METER ASSEMBLY
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - ECM)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
551
05-22
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05F45-05
O2S TEST RESULT
1.
INTRODUCTION
The O2S TEST RESULT refers to the results of the engine control module (ECM) when it monitors the oxygen sensor (O2S),
and it can be read using the hand-held tester or the generic
OBD II scan tool. Based on this, you can find the O2S’s conditions.
The ECM monitors the O2S for various data. You can read the
monitor result (TEST DATA) of each monitor item using the O2S
TEST RESULT. However, the output value of the TEST DATA
is the latest ”snapshot” value that is taken after monitoring and
therefore it is not dynamic.
In this repair manual, the description of the O2S TEST RESULT
(for O2S related DTCs) are written in a table.
This table consists of 5 items:
(1) TEST ID (a code applied to each TEST DATA)
(2) Description of TEST DATA
(3) Conversion Factor (When conversion factor has a
value written in the table, multiply the TEST DATA
value appearing on the scan tool by the conversion
factor value. The result will be the required value.)
(4) Unit
(5) Standard Value
If the TEST DATA value appearing on the scan tool is out of the
standard value, the O2S is malfunctioning. If it is within the standard value, the O2S is functioning normally. However, if the value is on the borderline of the standard value, the O2S may malfunction very soon.
2.
HOW TO READ O2S TEST RESULT USING HANDHELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b)
O2S TEST RESULT Screen
01 BANK 1 - SENSOR 1
On the tester screen, select the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / CARB OBDII / O2S TEST RESULT. A list of the
O2S equipped on the vehicle will be displayed.
01 BANK 1 - SENSOR 2
01 BANK 2 - SENSOR 1
01 BANK 2 - SENSOR 2
A21190
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
212
05-23
DIAGNOSTICS
(c)
TEST DATA Screen
LOW SW V ⋅ ⋅ ⋅
HIGH SW V ⋅ ⋅ ⋅
MIN O2S V ⋅ ⋅ ⋅
MAX O2S V ⋅ ⋅ ⋅
TIME $81 ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅
(d)
0.400 V
0.550 V
0.100 V
0.900 V
17
(e)
A21191
TEST ID
$81
Description of TEST DATA
Percentage of monitoring
time when the O2S voltage
is less than 0.05 V
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Select the desired O2S and press ENTER. The following
screen will appear.
Press HELP and simultaneously. More information will
appear.
Example:
(1) The hand-held tester displays ”17” as a value of the
”TIME $81” (see the illustration on the left).
(2) Find the conversion factor value of ”TIME $81” in
the O2S TEST RESULT chart below. 0.3906 is specified for $81 in this chart.
(3) Multiply ”17” in step (1) by 0.3906 (conversion factor) in the step (2).
17 x 0.3906 = 6.6 %
(4) If the answer is within the standard value, the ”TIME
$81” can be confirmed to be normal.
O2S TEST RESULT Chart:
Conversion Factor
Multiply 0.3906
Unit
%
Standard Value
Within 60 %
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
213
05-55
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0010
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EST-05
CAMSHAFT POSITION ”A” ACTUATOR
CIRCUIT (BANK 1)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system includes the ECM, the Oil Control Valve (OCV) and the VVT controller. The ECM sends a target duty-cycle control signal to the OCV. This control signal, sent to the OCV, regulates the oil pressure applied to the VVT controller. Camshaft timing control is performed based on engine
operation conditions such as intake air volume, throttle position and engine coolant temperature.
The ECM controls the OCV based on the signals output from several sensors. The VVT controller regulates
the intake camshaft angle using oil pressure through the OCV. As a result, the relative position between the
camshaft and the crankshaft is optimized. Also, the engine torque and fuel economy improve, and exhaust
emissions decrease. The ECM detects the actual valve timing using signals from the camshaft position sensor and the crankshaft position sensor. The ECM performs feedback control and verifies target valve timing.
ECM
Crankshaft Position Sensor
MAF Meter
OCV
Target Valve Timing
Throttle Position Sensor
Feedback
Duty Control
ECT Sensor
Correction
Vehicle Speed Signal
Camshaft Position Sensor
Actual Valve Timing
A71007
DTC No.
P0010
DTC Detection Condition
Open or short in OCV circuit
Trouble Area
Open or short in OCV circuit
OCV
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
245
05-56
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
After the ECM sends the ”target” duty-cycle signal to the OCV, the ECM monitors the OCV current to establish an ”actual” duty-cycle. When the actual duty-cycle ratio varies from the target duty-cycle ratio, the ECM
sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0010: VVT OCV range check
Required sensors / components (Main)
VVT OCV
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
1 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Target duty ratio for the OCV
70 % or less
Starter
OFF
Current cut status for the OCV
Not cut
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following condition is met:
OCV duty ratio
100 % (always ON) despite the target duty ratio is less than 70 %
OCV duty ratio when ECM supplies current to OCV
3 % or less despite the ECM is supplying current to the OCV
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VVT OCV duty ratio
More than 3 % and less than 100 %
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
246
05-57
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
C2
OCV
1
G-W
16
OC1+
E9
2
G-R
15
OC1E9
A87978
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Hand-held tester:
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER (OCV OPERATION)
Start the engine and warm it up.
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn ON the ignition switch. Push the hand-held tester main switch.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VVT CTRL B1.
Using the hand-held tester, operate the OCV and check the engine speed.
Standard:
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
OCV is OFF
Normal engine speed
OCV is ON
Rough idle or engine stall
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
NG
2
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY (OCV) (See page
10-2 )
OK: OCV has no contamination and moves smoothly.
NG
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL
VALVE ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
247
05-58
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK ECM (OCV SIGNAL)
(a)
E9
ECM
OC1 +
During idling, check the waveform of the ECM connector
using an oscilloscope.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-16 (OC1+) - E9-15 (OC1-)
Correct waveform is as shown
OC1-
OCV Signal Waveform
5 V/
Division
GND
1 msec./Division
NG
A87357
A67528
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (OCV - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
C2
OCV
OC1+
Disconnect the C2 OCV connector.
Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C2-1 (OCV) - E9-16 (OC1+)
C2-2 (OCV) - E9-15 (OC1-)
Below 1 Ω
C2-1 (OCV) or E9-16 (OC1+) - Body ground
C2-2 (OCV) or E9-15 (OC1-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E9
ECM
OC1Y
A54386
A81698
A85431
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
248
05-59
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY (OPERATE OCV)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Wire Harness Side
C2
OCV
Start the engine and warm it up.
Disconnect the OCV connector.
Apply battery positive voltage to the terminals of the OCV.
Check the engine speed.
OK: Rough idle or engine stalled.
NG
A53155
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL
VALVE ASSY
OK
2
CHECK ECM (OCV SIGNAL)
(a)
E9
ECM
OC1 +
During idling, check the waveform of the ECM connector
using an oscilloscope.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-16 (OC1+) - E9-15 (OC1-)
Correct waveform is as shown
OC1-
OCV Signal Waveform
5 V/
Division
GND
1 msec./Division
A67528
A87357
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
249
05-60
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (OCV - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
C2
OCV
OC1+
Disconnect the C2 OCV connector.
Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C2-1 (OCV) - E9-16 (OC1+)
C2-2 (OCV) - E9-15 (OC1-)
Below 1 Ω
C2-1 (OCV) or E9-16 (OC1+) - Body ground
C2-2 (OCV) or E9-15 (OC1-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E9
ECM
OC1Y
A54386
A81698
NG
A85431
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
250
05-61
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ESU-05
DTC
P0011
CAMSHAFT POSITION ”A” -TIMING OVERADVANCED OR SYSTEM PERFORMANCE
(BANK 1)
DTC
P0012
CAMSHAFT POSITION ”A” -TIMING OVERRETARDED (BANK 1)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0010 on page 05-55 .
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0011
After engine is warmed up and engine speed is at 550 to 4,000
rpm, condition (a) continues (1 trip detection logic)
(a) Valve timing does not change from current valve timing
(Problem of advanced valve timing)
Valve timing
OCV
VVT controller assembly
ECM
Trouble Area
P0012
After engine is warmed up and engine speed is at 550 to 4,000
rpm, condition (a) continues (2 trip detection logic)
(a) Valve timing does not change from current valve timing
(Problem of retarded valve timing)
Same as DTC No. P0011
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM optimizes the valve timing using the Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system to control the intake valve
camshaft. The VVT system includes the ECM, the Oil Control Valve (OCV) and the VVT controller. The ECM
sends a target duty-cycle control signal to the OCV. This control signal, sent to the OCV, regulates the oil
pressure applied to the VVT controller. The VVT controller can advance or retard the intake valve camshaft.
Example:
A DTC will be set if: 1) the difference between the ”target” and ”actual” valve timing is more than 5 degrees
of the camshaft angle (CA) and the condition continues for more than 4.5 seconds; or 2) the OCV is forcibly
activated 63 times or more.
Advanced cam DTCs are subject to ”1 trip” detection logic.
Retarded cam DTCs are subject to ”2 trip” detection logic.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0011: Advanced camshaft timing
P0012: Retarded camshaft timing
Required sensors / components (Main)
VVT OCV and VVT Actuators
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP, CMP and ECT sensors
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 10 sec.
MIL operation
P0011: Immediate
P0012: 2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
Engine RPM
550 to 4,000 rpm
ECT
75 to 100C (167 to 212F)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
251
05-62
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Deviation of valve timing
More than 5CA (Crankshaft Angle)
OCV activation
63 times or more
Response of valve timing
1 sec./CA or more (valve timing does not change)
If the difference between ”target” and ”actual” camshaft timing is larger than the specified value, the ECM
operates the VVT actuator.
The ECM then monitors the camshaft timing change for 5 seconds.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0010 on page 05-55 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Abnormal bank
Problem of advanced OCV
Problem of retarded OCV
Bank 1
P0011
P0012
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Hand-held tester:
1
(a)
CHECK VALVE TIMING (See page 14-68 )
Check for a loose or jumped tooth of the timing chain.
OK: The matchmarks of the crankshaft pulley and camshaft pulley are aligned.
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING (See page 14-68 )
OK
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER (OPERATE OF OCV)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine and warm it up.
Turn ON the ignition switch. Push the hand-held tester main switch.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VVT CTRL B1.
Using the hand-held tester, operate the OCV and check the engine speed.
Standard:
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
OCV is OFF
Normal engine speed
OCV is ON
Rough idle or engine stall
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
252
05-63
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUTS REOCCUR
Erase the DTC(s) using one of the following methods: 1) use the hand-held tester, 2) disconnect the
battery cable for more than 60 seconds, or 3) remove the EFI NO. 1 and ETCS fuses for more than
60 seconds.
HINT:
After disconnecting the battery cable, perform the ”INITIALIZE” procedure (see page 05-893 ).
(b) Start and warm up the engine.
(c) Drive the vehicle for 10 minutes or more.
(d) Read output DTC using the hand-held tester.
OK: No DTC is output.
OK
VVT SYSTEM OK*
HINT:
*: DTCs P0011 and P0012 are output when a foreign object in
the engine oil enters the system. These codes will stay even if
the system returns to normal after a short time. Foreign objects
are filtered out by the oil filter.
NG
4
CHECK ECM (OCV SIGNAL)
(a)
E9
ECM
OC1 +
During idling, check the waveform of the ECM connector
using an oscilloscope.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-16 (OC1+) - E9-15 (OC1-)
Correct waveform is as shown
OC1-
OCV Signal Waveform
5 V/
Division
GND
1 msec./Division
A67528
A87357
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
253
05-64
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
OK: The filter is not clogged.
NG
REPLACE OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
OK
6
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY (OCV) (See page
10-2 )
OK: OCV has no contamination and moves smoothly.
OK
Go to step 8
NG
7
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY (OCV)
GO
8
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY (See page 14-79 )
OK: Camshaft timing gear rotates smoothly when pressure is applied.
OK
Go to step 10
NG
9
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
GO
10
CHECK FOR BLOCKAGE (OCV, OIL CHECK VALVE AND OIL HOLE)
OK: No blockage
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
254
05-65
DIAGNOSTICS
11
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUTS REOCCUR
Erase the DTC(s) using one of the following methods: 1) use the hand-held tester, 2) disconnect the
battery cable for more than 60 seconds, or 3) remove the EFI NO. 1 and ETCS fuses for more than
60 seconds.
HINT:
After disconnecting the battery cable, perform the ”INITIALIZE” procedure (see page 05-893 ).
(b) Start and warm up the engine.
(c) Drive the vehicle for 10 minutes or more.
(d) Read output DTC using the hand-held tester.
OK: No DTC is output.
OK
VVT SYSTEM OK*
HINT:
*: DTCs P0011 and P0012 are output when a foreign object in
the engine oil enters the system. These codes will stay even if
the system returns to normal after a short time. Foreign objects
are filtered out by the oil filter.
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
(a)
CHECK VALVE TIMING (See page 14-68 )
Check for loose or jumped tooth of timing chain.
OK: The matchmarks of the crankshaft pulley and camshaft pulley are alined.
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING (See page 14-68 )
OK
2
INSPECT OPERATION OF OCV
(a)
(b)
C2
OCV
(-)
Start the engine.
Check the engine speed with (1) and (2).
(1) Disconnect the C2 OCV connector.
(2) Apply battery positive voltage between the terminals of the OCV.
Result:
(+)
A76968
B
Proceed to
Check (1)
Check (2)
A
Normal engine speed
Rough idle or engine stall
B
Conditions other than A
Conditions other than A
Go to step 4
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
255
05-66
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUTS REOCCUR
Erase the DTC(s) using one of the following methods: 1) use the hand-held tester, 2) disconnect the
battery cable for more than 60 seconds, or 3) remove the EFI NO. 1 and ETCS fuses for more than
60 seconds.
HINT:
After disconnecting the battery cable, perform the ”INITIALIZE” procedure (see page 05-893 ).
(b) Start and warm up the engine.
(c) Drive the vehicle for 10 minutes or more.
(d) Read output DTC using the hand-held tester.
OK: No DTC is output.
OK
VVT SYSTEM OK*
HINT:
*: DTCs P0011 and P0012 are output when a foreign object in
the engine oil enters the system. These codes will stay even if
the system returns to normal after a short time. Foreign objects
are filtered out by the oil filter.
NG
4
CHECK ECM (OCV SIGNAL)
(a)
E9
ECM
OC1 +
During idling, check the waveform of the ECM connector
using an oscilloscope.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-16 (OC1+) - E9-15 (OC1-)
Correct waveform is as shown
OC1-
OCV Signal Waveform
5 V/
Division
GND
1 msec./Division
A67528
A87357
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
256
05-67
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
OK: The filter is not clogged.
NG
REPLACE OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
OK
6
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY (OCV) (See page
10-2 )
OK: OCV has no contamination and moves smoothly.
OK
Go to step 8
NG
7
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY (OCV)
GO
8
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY (See page 14-79 )
OK: Camshaft timing gear rotates smoothly when pressure is applied.
OK
Go to step 10
NG
9
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
GO
10
CHECK FOR BLOCKAGE (OCV, OIL CHECK VALVE AND OIL HOLE)
OK: No blockage
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
257
05-68
DIAGNOSTICS
11
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUTS REOCCUR
Erase the DTC(s) using one of the following methods: 1) use the hand-held tester, 2) disconnect the
battery cable for more than 60 seconds, or 3) remove the EFI NO. 1 and ETCS fuses for more than
60 seconds.
HINT:
After disconnecting the battery cable, perform the ”INITIALIZE” procedure (see page 05-893 ).
(b) Start and warm up the engine.
(c) Drive the vehicle for 10 minutes or more.
(d) Read output DTC using the hand-held tester.
OK: No DTC is output.
OK
VVT SYSTEM OK*
HINT:
*: DTCs P0011 and P0012 are output when a foreign object in
the engine oil enters the system. These codes will stay even if
the system returns to normal after a short time. Foreign objects
are filtered out by the oil filter.
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
258
05-69
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0016
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
0520A-16
CRANKSHAFT POSITION - CAMSHAFT
POSITION CORRELATION (BANK 1 SENSOR
A)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0335 and P0339 on page 05-166 .
DTC No.
P0016
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Deviation in crankshaft position sensor signal and VVT sensor
(bank 1) signal (2 trip detection logic)
Mechanical system (jumped tooth of timing chain, chain
stretched)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM optimizes the valve timing using the Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system to control the intake valve
camshaft. The VVT system includes the ECM, the Oil Control Valve (OCV) and the VVT controller. The ECM
sends a target duty-cycle control signal to the OCV. This control signal, sent to the OCV, regulates the oil
pressure applied to the VVT controller. The VVT controller can advance or retard the intake valve camshaft.
The ECM calibrates the valve timing of the VVT system by setting the camshaft to the maximum retard angle
when the engine is idling. The ECM closes the OCV to retard the cam. The ECM stores this value as a VVT
learning value. When the difference between the target valve timing and the actual valve timing is 5 degrees
or less, the ECM stores this in its memory.
If the learning value meets both of the following conditions (”a” and ”b”), the ECM interprets this as a defect
in the VVT system and sets a DTC.
(a) The VVT learning value is less than 27CA or more than 49CA.
(b) The Above condition continues for more than 18 seconds.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0016: Camshaft timing misalignment at Idling
Required sensors / components (Main)
VVT actuator
Required sensors / components (Related)
CMP and CKP sensors
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 60 sec.
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
Engine RPM
550 to 1,400 rpm
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Duration that either of the following conditions 1 or 2 is met
18 sec. or more
1. VVT angle when camshaft is retarded maximum
Less than 27CA
2. VVT angle when camshaft is retarded maximum
More than 49CA
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
259
05-70
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTCs P0335 and P0339 on page 05-166 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
CHECK VALVE TIMING (See page 14-68 )
Check for loose or jumped tooth of timing chain.
OK: The matchmarks of the crankshaft pulley and camshaft pulley are alined.
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING (See page 14-68 )
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
260
05-71
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ET1-06
DTC
P0031
OXYGEN (A/F) SENSOR HEATER CONTROL
CIRCUIT LOW (BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
DTC
P0032
OXYGEN SENSOR HEATER CONTROL
CIRCUIT HIGH (BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
HINT:
Although the title (DTC description) says ”oxygen sensor”, this DTC is related to the ”A/F sensor”.
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-269 .
HINT:
The ECM provides a pulse width modulated control circuit to adjust current through the heater. The A/F sensor heater circuit uses a relay on the +B side of the circuit.
Reference
A/F Sensor
Heater
HT
+B
EFI Relay
From
Battery
EFI NO. 2
Sensor
Fuse AFAF+
EFI NO. 1
Fuse
ECM
HA1A
A1A+
Duty
Control
A1AMREL
A90346
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0031
Heater current of 0.8 A or less when heater operates
(1 trip detection logic)
Open in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
ECM
P0032
Heater current exceeds 10 A when heater operates
(1 trip detection logic)
Short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
ECM
HINT:
Sensor 1 is the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
261
05-72
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses A/F sensor information to keep the air/fuel ratio close to the stoichiometric ratio. This maximizes the catalytic converter’s ability to purify exhaust gas. The sensor detects oxygen levels in the exhaust
gas and sends this signal to the ECM.
The inner surface of the sensor element is exposed to outside air. The outer surface of the sensor element
is exposed to exhaust gas. The sensor element is made of platinum coated zirconia and includes an integrated heating element. The zirconia element generates small voltage when there is a large difference in
the oxygen concentrations of the exhaust and the outside air. The platinum coating amplifies the voltage
generation. When heated, the sensor becomes very efficient. If the temperature of the exhaust is low, the
sensor will not generate useful voltage signals without supplemental heating. The ECM regulates the supplemental heating using a duty-cycle approach to regulate the average current in the heater element. If the
heater current is out of the normal range, the sensor’s output signals will be inaccurate and the ECM cannot
regulate the A/F ratio properly.
When the heater current is out of the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction and
sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0031: A/F sensor heater range check (Low current)
P0032: A/F sensor heater range check (High current)
Required sensors / components (Main)
A/F sensor heater
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
P0031:
Battery voltage
Less than 10.5 V
A/F sensor heater duty ratio
50 % or more
Time after engine start
10 sec. or more
P0032:
Time after engine start
10 sec. or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0031:
A/F sensor heater current
Less than 0.8 A
P0032:
A/F sensor heater current
More than 10 A
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
A/F sensor heater current
1.8 to 3.4 A at 20°C (68°F)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
262
05-73
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-24 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-26 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $07: A/F sensor heater
TLT
CID
1
$01
Unit Conversion
Description of Test Data
Multiply by 0.00017
(A)
Maximum heater current
Description of Test Limit
Malfunction criterion for A/F sensor heater
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-269 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
A6
A/F sensor
AF-
AF+
Disconnect the A6 A/F sensor connector.
Measure the resistance between the terminals of the A/F
sensor.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
20C (68F)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
-
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
A52607
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
263
05-74
DIAGNOSTICS
2
1
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT RELAY (EFI)
2
1
3
-
5
(a)
(b)
5
2
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3
NG
B60778
REPLACE RELAY
OK
3
CHECK ECM (HA1A VOLTAGE)
HA1A (+)
E8
ECM
E9
ECM
E1 (-)
A76903
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8-5 (HA1A) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
264
05-75
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - A/F SENSOR, A/F SENSOR - EFI RELAY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
E8
ECM
Check the wire harness between the ECM and A/F sensor.
(1) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(2) Disconnect the A6 A/F sensor connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
HA1A
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A6-1 (HT) - E8-5 (HA1A)
Below 1 Ω
A6-1 (HT) or E8-5 (HA1A) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A6
A/F Sensor
HT
1
3
2
4
+B
A81695
A76787
A85433
(b)
Wire Harness Side
A6
A/F Sensor
HT
1
3
2
4
+B
Check the wire harness between the A/F sensor and EFI
relay.
(1) Disconnect the A6 A/F sensor connector.
(2) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Engine Room J/B
A6-2 (+B) - J/B EFI relay terminal 3
Below 1 Ω
A6-2 (+B) or J/B EFI relay terminal 3 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
EFI Relay
A90291
A76787
A90920
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
265
05-76
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ETE-05
DTC
P0037
OXYGEN SENSOR HEATER CONTROL
CIRCUIT LOW (BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
DTC
P0038
OXYGEN SENSOR HEATER CONTROL
CIRCUIT HIGH (BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0136 on page 05-1 18.
HINT:
The ECM provides a pulse width a modulated control circuit to adjust current through the heater. The oxygen
sensor heater circuit uses a relay on the +B side of the circuit.
Reference
Heated Oxygen Sensor
EFI Relay
From
Battery
EFI NO. 1
Fuse
ECM
+B Heater HT
HT1B
EFI NO. 2
Sensor
E1
Fuse
OX
OX1B
Duty
Control
OB1MREL
A90346
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0037
Heater current of less than 0.3 A when the heater operates
with +B greater than 10.5 V
(1 trip detection logic)
Open or short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater
EFI relay
ECM
P0038
Heater current exceeds 2 A when heater operates
(1 trip detection logic)
Same as DTC No. P0037
HINT:
Sensor 2 is the sensor farthest away from the engine assembly.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The sensing portion of the heated oxygen sensor has a zirconia element that is used to detect oxygen concentration in the exhaust. If the zirconia element is at the proper temperature and the difference of the oxygen concentration between the inside and outside surface of the sensor is large, the zirconia element will
generate voltage signals. In order to increase the oxygen concentration detecting capacity in the zirconia
element, the ECM supplements the heat from the exhaust with heat from a heating element inside the sensor. When current in the sensor is out of the standard operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in
the heated oxygen sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
The ECM will set a high current DTC if the current in the sensor is more than 2 A when the heater is OFF.
Similarly, the ECM will set a low current DTC if the current is less than 0.25 A when the heater is ON.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
266
05-77
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0037: HO2S heater range check (Low current)
P0038: HO2S heater range check (High current)
Required sensors / components (Main)
Heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) heater
Required sensors / components (Related)
Vehicle speed sensor (VSS)
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.3 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
P0037:
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Engine
Running
Starter
OFF
Intrusive heating
Not operated
P0038 (Case 1):
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Engine
Running
Starter
OFF
Intrusive heating
Not operated
P0038 (Case 2):
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
All heater is turned OFF and intrusive heating is operated
when the following conditions are met
Condition 1 and 2
1. Heater
ON
2. Heater current
2 A or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0037:
HO2S heater current intrusive heating
Less than 0.3 A
P0038 (Case 1):
HO2S heater current
2 A or more
P0038 (Case 2):
HO2S heater current intrusive heating
More than 2 A
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
HO2S heater current
0.4 to 1 A (when engine is idle, warmed-up and battery voltage is 11 to 14 V)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
267
05-78
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-24 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-26 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $04: HO2S heater
TLT
1
CID
$02
Unit Conversion
Description of Test Data
Multiply by 0.000076
(A)
Description of Test Limit
Maximum HO2S heater current
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Malfunction threshold for HO2S heater
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0136 on page 05-1 18.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
H10
Heated Oxygen Sensor
HT
OX
+B
E1
Disconnect the H10 heated oxygen sensor connector.
Measure the resistance of the heated oxygen sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
H10-2 (HT) - H10-1 (+B)
20C (68F)
11 to 16 Ω
H10-2 (HT) - H10-1 (+B)
800C (1,472F)
23 to 32 Ω
NG
Specified Condition
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
A80018
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
268
05-79
DIAGNOSTICS
2
1
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT RELAY (EFI)
2
1
3
-
5
5
2
(a)
(b)
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (HT1B VOLTAGE)
HT1B (+)
E1 (-)
E8
ECM
E9
ECM
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8-21 (HT1B) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
A76903
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
269
05-80
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR, HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR - EFI RELAY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
E8
ECM
Check the wire harness between the ECM and heated oxygen sensor.
(1) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(2) Disconnect the H10 heated oxygen sensor connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
HT1B
H10
Heated Oxygen Sensor
+B
HT
E1
OX
A81695
A80019
Specified Condition
H10-2 (HT) - E8-21 (HT1B)
Below 1 Ω
H10-2 (HT) or E8-21 (HT1B) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A91528
(b)
Wire Harness Side
H10
Heated Oxygen Sensor
+B
HT
E1
OX
Check the wire harness between the heated oxygen sensor and EFI relay.
(1) Disconnect the H10 heated oxygen sensor connector.
(2) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Below 1 Ω
H10-1 (+B) or J/B EFI relay terminal 3 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Engine Room J/B
EFI Relay
A80019
A90291
NG
A91529
Specified Condition
H10-1 (+B) - J/B EFI relay terminal 3
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
270
05-81
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ESV-05
DTC
P0100
MASS OR VOLUME AIR FLOW CIRCUIT
DTC
P0102
MASS OR VOLUME AIR FLOW CIRCUIT
LOW INPUT
DTC
P0103
MASS OR VOLUME AIR FLOW CIRCUIT
HIGH INPUT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter measures the amount of air flowing through the throttle valve. The ECM uses
this information to determine the fuel injection time and provide a proper air fuel ratio. Inside the MAF meter,
there is a heated platinum wire exposed to the flow of intake air.
By applying a specific current to the wire, the ECM heats this wire to a given temperature. The flow of incoming air cools the wire and an internal thermistor, changing their resistance. To maintain a constant current
value, the ECM varies the voltage applied to these components in the MAF meter. The voltage level is proportional to the air flow through the sensor. The ECM interprets this voltage as the intake air amount.
The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire and temperature sensor provide a bridge circuit, with
the power transistor controlled so that the potential of A and B remains equal to maintain the set temperature.
B+
Temperature Sensor
Power Transistor
Platinum Hot Wire
(Heater)
B
A
Output
Voltage
Temperature
Sensor
Platinum Hot Wire (Heater)
A80089
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0100
When MAF meter circuit has an open or a short for more than
3 seconds
Open or short in MAF meter circuit
MAF meter
ECM
P0102
When MAF meter circuit has an open for more than 3 seconds
Same as DTC No. P0100
P0103
When MAF meter circuit has a short for more than 3 seconds
Same as DTC No. P0100
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0100, P0102 or P0103, use the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to confirm
the MAF ratio from the ALL menu (to reach the ALL menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST
/ ALL).
Air Flow Value (g/s)
Approximately 0.0
271.0 or more
Malfunction
Open in MAF meter power source circuit
Open or short in VG circuit
Open in EVG circuit
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
271
05-82
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is a defect in the sensor, or an open or short circuit, the voltage level will deviate from the normal
operating range. The ECM interprets this deviation as a defect in the MAF meter and sets a DTC.
Example:
The sensor voltage output is less than 0.2 V or more than 4.9 V and either condition continues for more than
3 seconds.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0100: MAF meter range check (Chattering)
P0102: MAF meter range check(Low voltage)
P0103: MAF meter range check (High voltage)
Required sensors / components (Main)
MAF Meter
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP (Crank shaft position) sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
3 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate: Engine RPM is less than 4,000 rpm
2 driving cycles: Engine RPM is 4,000 rpm or more
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0100:
MAF meter voltage
Less than 0.2 V, or more than 4.9 V
P0102:
MAF meter voltage
Less than 0.2 V
P0103:
MAF meter voltage
More than 4.9 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
MAF meter voltage
Between 0.4 and 2.2 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
272
05-83
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
M1
MAF Meter
Engine Room R/B No. 2
EFI NO. 2
2
B-W
2
1
EB1
B-R
+B
VG
1
1 2
ECM
R
30
VG
E7
L-W
29
EVG
E7
3
E2G
2
Y
5V
P-L
3 2D
13
B
IK3
8
E5
MREL
2B 5
3
1
5
2
EFI
Relay
Engine Room J/B
EFI
NO. 1
1 2I
2F 4
W
3
F7
FL
Block
Assy 1
W
W-B
A
J2
J/C
FL
Main
Battery
EH
A90347
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
273
05-84
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (MAF RATE)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / MAF. Read the values.
Result:
Air Flow Rate (gm/second)
Proceed to
0.0
A
271.0 or more
B
MAF rate greater than 1 but less than 270.0 *
C
HINT:
*: The value must change when the throttle valve is opened or closed.
B
Go to step 6
C
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
A
2
CHECK MASS AIR FLOW METER (POWER SOUCE VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
M1
MAF Meter
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-1 (+B) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
+B (+)
A54396
NG
Go to step 5
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
274
05-85
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM (VG VOLTAGE)
VG (+)
(a)
(b)
EVG (-)
Start the engine.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E7-30 (VG) - E7-29 (EVG)
Engine is idling
0.5 to 3.0 V
HINT:
The shift position should be P or N and the A/C switch should
be turned OFF.
E7
ECM
A76903
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
NG
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MAF METER - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
M1
MAF Meter
EVG
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
VG
E7
ECM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-3 (VG) - E7-30 (VG)
M1-2 (EVG) - E7-29 (EVG)
Below 1 Ω
M1-3 (VG) or E7-30 (VG) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
EVG
Y
A54396
A81699
VG
A85482
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
275
05-86
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MAF METER - EFI RELAY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
M1
MAF Meter
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-1 (+B) - J/B EFI relay terminal 3
Below 1 Ω
M1-1 (+B) or J/B EFI relay terminal 3 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
+B (+)
Engine Room J/B
EFI Relay
A54396
A90291
A90959
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
INSPECT ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT (See page 05-312 )
6
INSPECT ECM (SENSOR GROUND)
(a)
EVG
E7
ECM
A76903
Measure the resistance of the ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-29 (EVG) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
276
05-87
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MAF METER - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
M1
MAF Meter
EVG
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
VG
E7
ECM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-3 (VG) - E7-30 (VG)
M1-2 (EVG) - E7-29 (EVG)
Below 1 Ω
M1-3 (VG) or E7-30 (VG) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
EVG
Y
A54396
A81699
VG
A85482
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
277
05-88
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0101
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
051ZM-14
MASS OR VOLUME AIR FLOW CIRCUIT
RANGE/PERFORMANCE PROBLEM
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0100 on page 05-81 .
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0101
High voltage:
Conditions (a), (b) and (c) continue for more than 10 seconds
(2 trip detection logic):
(a) Engine speed less than 2,000 rpm
(b) Engine coolant temperature 70C (158F) or higher
(c) Voltage output of Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter more than 2.2
V (varies with Throttle Position [TP] sensor voltage)
Low voltage:
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for more than 10 seconds
(2 trip detection logic):
(a) Engine speed more than 300 rpm
(b) Voltage output of MAF meter less than 0.65 V
(varies with TP sensor voltage)
Trouble Area
MAF meter
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The MAF meter is a sensor that measures the amount of air flowing through the throttle valve. The ECM uses
this information to determine the fuel injection time and to provide an appropriate air-fuel ratio.
Inside the MAF meter, there is a heated platinum wire which is exposed to the flow of intake air. By applying
a specific electrical current to the wire, the ECM heats it to a specific temperature. The flow of incoming air
cools both the wire and an internal thermistor, changing their resistance. To maintain a constant current value, the ECM varies the voltage applied to these components of the MAF meter. The voltage level is proportional to the air flow through the sensor, and the ECM uses it to calculate the intake air volume.
If there is a defect in the sensor, or an open or short in the circuit, the voltage level deviates from the normal
operating range. The ECM interprets this deviation as a malfunction in the MAF meter and sets the DTC.
Example:
If the voltage is more than 2.2 V, or less than 0.65 V while idling, the ECM determines that there is a malfunction in the MAF meter and sets the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0101: MAF Meter Rationality (Low voltage)
P0101: MAF Meter Rationality (High voltage)
Required sensors/ components (Main)
MAF meter
Required sensors/ components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor, ECT sensor, Throttle position sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
278
05-89
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
MAF Meter Rationality (High Voltage):
Engine RPM
Less than 2,000 rpm
ECT
70°C (158°F) or more
MAF meter voltage
4.9 V or less
MAF Meter Rationality (Low Voltage):
Engine RPM
More than 300 rpm
MAF meter voltage
0.2 V or more
Fuel cut
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
MAF Meter Rationality (High Voltage):
MAF meter voltage
More than 2.2 V (varies with throttle position sensor voltage)
MAF Meter Rationality (Low Voltage):
MAF meter voltage
Less than 0.65 V (varies with throttle position sensor voltage)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0100 on page 05-81 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0101)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0101 and other DTCs are output
A
Only P0101 is output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0101 are output, perform the troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
A
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART (See page 05-48 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
279
05-90
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
0596B-07
DTC
P0110
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT
DTC
P0112
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT LOW
INPUT
DTC
P0113
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT HIGH
INPUT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Fig. 1
30
20
Resistance kΩ
10
Acceptable
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
- 20
(- 4)
0
32
20
68
40
104
60
140
80
176
100
212
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor, mounted on the Mass
Air Flow (MAF) meter, monitors the intake air temperature. The
IAT sensor has a thermistor that varies its resistance depending
on the temperature of the intake air. When the air temperature
is low, the resistance in the thermistor increases. When the temperature is high, the resistance drops. The variations in resistance are reflected as changes in voltage applied to the ECM
terminal (see Fig. 1).
The IAT sensor is connected to the ECM (see below). The 5 V
power source voltage in the ECM is applied to the IAT sensor
from terminal THA via resistor R.
That is, the resistor R and the IAT sensor are connected in series. When the resistance value of the IAT sensor changes in
accordance with changes in the IAT, the voltage at terminal THA
also changes. Based on this signal, the ECM increases the fuel
injection volume to improve the driveability during cold engine
operation.
Temperature C (F)
A67628
DTC No.
Proceed to
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0110
Step 1
Open or short in IAT (Intake
air temperature) sensor circuit for 0.5 seconds
(1 trip detection logic)
P0112
Step 4
Short in IAT sensor circuit for
0.5 seconds
(1 trip detection logic)
Same as DTC No. P0110
P0113
Step 2
Open in IAT sensor circuit for
0.5 seconds
(1 trip detection logic)
Same as DTC No. P0110
Open or short in IAT sensor circuit
IAT sensor (built-in MAF meter)
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0110, P0112 or P0113, use the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to confirm
the IAT from the ALL menu (to reach the ALL menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL).
Temp. Displayed
Malfunction
-40 °C (-40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F) or more
Short circuit
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
280
05-91
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the intake air temperature. When the
sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the IAT
sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
The sensor voltage output is -40C (-40F), or more than 140C (284F) and either condition continues
for 0.5 seconds or more.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0110: IAT sensor range check (Chattering)
P0112: IAT sensor range check (Low Resistance)
P0113: IAT sensor range check (High Resistance)
Required sensors / components (Main)
IAT sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0110:
IAT sensor resistance
Less than 98.5 Ω, or more than 156 kΩ
P0112:
IAT sensor resistance [IAT]
Less than 98.5 Ω [More than 140C (284F)]
P0113:
IAT sensor resistance [IAT]
More than 156 kΩ [-40C (-40F)]
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
IAT sensor resistance [IAT]
98.5 Ω to 156 kΩ [-39 to 140C (-40 to 284F)]
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
281
05-92
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
M1
MAF Meter
(IAT Sensor)
ECM
5V
5
20
THA
E7
L-B
4
G
BR
Short
Connector
5
5
S29
S28
28
BR
E7
E2
A90293
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs that are related to different systems are output simultaneously while terminal E2 is used as
a ground terminal, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (INTAKE AIR
TEMPERATURE)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Turn ON the ignition switch. Push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR. Read the values.
Temperature: The same as actual intake air temperature.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
-40 °C (-40°F)
A
140°C (284°F) or more
B
OK (same as present temperature)
C
HINT:
If there is an open circuit, the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool indicates -40°C (-40°F).
If there is a short circuit, the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool indicates 140°C (284°F) or more.
B
Go to step 4
C
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
282
05-93
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
OPEN IN HARNESS)
M1
MAF Meter
(a)
(b)
ECM
(c)
(d)
THA
E2
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Connect terminals THA and E2 of the M1 MAF meter wire
harness side connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
Wire Harness Side
M1
MAF Meter
THA
E2
OK
Y
A75743
A76903
A85506
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER (IAT SENSOR)
NG
3
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
OPEN IN ECM)
M1
MAF Meter
(a) Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
(b) Connect terminals THA and E2 of the E7 ECM connector.
HINT:
Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check for the
ECM connector.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(d) On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
ECM
THA
E2
THA
Y
A75742
A76903
E2
E7
ECM
OK
A85507
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
283
05-94
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION AT ECM. IF OK, REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
4
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
SHORT IN HARNESS)
M1
MAF Meter
(a)
(b)
(c)
ECM
THA
E2
A75766
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: -40°C (-40°F)
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
NG
5
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
SHORT IN ECM)
M1
MAF Meter
(a)
(b)
(c)
ECM
THA
E2
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: -40°C (-40°F)
E7
ECM
Y
A75744
A81699
OK
A85508
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
OR
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
284
05-95
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
0596C-07
DTC
P0115
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT
DTC
P0117
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT
LOW INPUT
DTC
P0118
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT
HIGH INPUT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor is built into the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor and changes the resistance value
according to the engine coolant temperature.
The structure of the sensor and connection to the ECM are the same as the Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
sensor.
HINT:
If the ECM detects the DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118, it operates the fail-safe function in which the ECT is
assumed to be 80C (176F).
DTC No.
Proceed to
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0115
Step 1
Open or short in ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
sensor circuit for 0.5 seconds
P0117
Step 4
Short in ECT sensor circuit
for 0.5 seconds
Same as DTC No. P0115
P0118
Step 2
Open in ECT sensor circuit
for 0.5 seconds
Same as DTC No. P0115
Open or short in ECT sensor circuit
ECT sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118, use the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to confirm
the ECT from the ALL menu (to reach the ALL menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL).
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-40 °C (-40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F) or more
Short circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECT sensor is used to monitor the engine coolant temperature. The ECT sensor has a thermistor that
varies its resistance depending on the temperature of the engine coolant. When the coolant temperature
is low, the resistance in the thermistor increases. When the temperature is high, the resistance drops. The
variations in resistance are reflected in the voltage output from the sensor.
The ECM monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the engine coolant temperature.
When the sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault
in the ECT sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
When the ECM calculates that the ECT is -40C (-40F) or more than 140C (284F) and if either condition
continues for 0.5 seconds or more, the ECM will set a DTC.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
285
05-96
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0115: ECT sensor range check (Chattering)
P0117: ECT sensor range check (Low resistance)
P0118: ECT sensor range check (High resistance)
Required sensors / components (Main)
ECT sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0115:
Less than 79 Ω or more than 156 kΩ
ECT sensor resistance
P0117:
Less than 79 Ω [More than 140C (284F)]
ECT sensor resistance [ECT]
P0118:
ECT sensor resistance [ECT]
More than 156 kΩ [-40C (-40F)]
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
79 Ω to 156 KΩ [-39 to 140C (-40 to 284F)]
ECT sensor resistance [ECT]
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
E2
ECT Sensor
THW
5V
E2 1
19
THW
E7
G-B
2
BR
BR
Short
Connector
5
5
S29
S28
BR
28
E7
R
E2
A90294
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
286
05-97
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs that are related to different systems are output simultaneously while terminal E2 is used as
a ground terminal, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (ENGINE
COOLANT TEMPERATURE)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Turn ON the ignition switch. Push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP. Read the values.
Temperature: Same value as the actual engine coolant temperature.
Result:
Temperature Displayed
Proceed to
-40 °C (-40°F)
A
140°C (284°F) or more
B
OK (same as present temperature)
C
HINT:
If there is an open circuit, the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool indicates -40°C (-40°F).
If there is a short circuit, the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool indicates 140°C (284°F) or more.
B
Go to step 4
C
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
287
05-98
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
OPEN IN WIRE HARNESS)
E2
ECT Sensor
(a)
(b)
ECM
(c)
(d)
THW
E2
Disconnect the E2 ECT sensor connector.
Connect terminals 1 and 2 of the E2 ECT sensor wire harness side connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
Wire Harness Side
E2
ECT Sensor
OK
Y
75743
A66104
A85509
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION AT SENSOR. IF
OK, REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMP.
SENSOR
NG
3
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
OPEN IN ECM)
E2
ECT Sensor
(a) Disconnect the E2 ECT sensor connector.
(b) Connect terminals THW and E2 of the E7 ECM connector.
HINT:
Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check for the
ECM connector.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(d) On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
ECM
THW
E2
THW
Y
A75742
A76903
E2
E7
ECM
A85507
OK
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
288
05-99
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION AT ECM. IF OK, REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
4
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
E2
ECT Sensor
(a)
(b)
(c)
ECM
THW
E2
Disconnect the E2 ECT sensor connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: -40°C (-40°F)
OK
A75766
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
NG
5
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
SHORT IN ECM)
E2
ECT Sensor
(a)
(b)
(c)
ECM
THW
E2
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: -40°C (-40°F)
E7
ECM
Y
A75744
A81699
OK
A85508
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
289
05-100
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0116
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
051ZP-14
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. CIRCUIT
RANGE/PERFORMANCE PROBLEM
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 on page 05-95 .
DTC No.
P0116
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
ECT is between 35°C (95°F) and 60°C (140°F) when engine
is started, and conditions (a) and (b) are met:
(a) Vehicle has accelerated and decelerated
(b) ECT remains within 3°C (5.4°F) of initial engine coolant
temperature
(2 trip detection logic)
ECT is more than 60°C (140°F) when engine is started and
vehicle has accelerated and decelerated
ECT sensor records a temperature variation is within 1°C
(1.8°F) successively 6 times
(6 trip detection logic)
Cooling system
ECT sensor
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to monitor the engine coolant temperature. The ECT
sensor has a thermistor that varies its resistance depending on the temperature of the engine coolant. When
the coolant temperature is low, the resistance in the thermistor increases. When the temperature is high, the
resistance drops. The variations in resistance are reflected in the voltage output from the sensor. The ECM
monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the engine coolant temperature. When the sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the ECT
sensor and sets a DTC.
Examples:
1) Upon starting the engine, the ECT is between 35C (95F) and 60C (140F). If, after driving for 250 seconds, the ECT still remains within 3C (5.4F) of the starting temperature, a DTC will be set (2 trip detection
logic).
2) Upon starting the engine, the ECT is over 60C (140F). If, after driving for 250 seconds, the ECT still
remains within 1C (1.8F) of the starting temperature, a DTC will be set (6 trip detection logic).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0116: ECT sensor stuck
P0116: ECT sensor stuck at high
Required sensors / components (Main)
ECT sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP sensor, IAT sensor, MAF meter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
250 sec. or more
MIL operation
2 driving cycles: ECT sensor stuck
6 driving cycles: ECT sensor stuck at high
Sequence of operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
290
05-101
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
ECT Sensor Stuck at Low ECT:
Cumulative idle off period
250 sec. or more
Speed increase by 30 km/h (18.6 mph) or more
10 times or more
ECT
35 to 60C (95 to 140F)
IAT
-6.7 C (20F) or more
ECT Sensor Stuck at High ECT:
ECT
60C (140F) or more
IAT
-6.7 C (20F) or more
”Stop and go”*1
Once or more
”Steady driving and stop*2
Once or more
*1
Vehicle is stopped for 20 seconds or more and accelerated to more than 43.5 mph (70 km/h) within 40
seconds.
*2 Vehicle is driven by 40.4 mph (65 km/h) or more for 30 seconds or more and the vehicle speed reaches
43.5 mph (70 km/h). The vehicle is decelerated from 40.4 mph (65 km/h) to 1.86 mph (3 km/h) or less within
35 seconds and stopped for 10 seconds.
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
ECT Sensor Stuck at Low ECT:
ECT change
Less than 3C (5.4F)
ECT sensor Stuck at High ECT:
ECT change
1C (1.8F) or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
ECT
Varies with actual ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 and P0125 are output simultaneously, the ECT sensor circuit
may be open or shorted. Perform the troubleshooting of DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118 first.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
291
05-102
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
0596D-07
DTC
P0120
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”A” CIRCUIT
DTC
P0122
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”A” CIRCUIT LOW INPUT
DTC
P0123
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”A” CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
DTC
P0220
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”B” CIRCUIT
DTC
P0223
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”B” CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
DTC
P2135
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”A”/”B” VOLTAGE
CORRELATION
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
292
05-103
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
HINT:
Throttle Position Sensor
ECM
Magnet
IC No. 1
VC
VTA1
Throttle Position Sensor Output Voltage (V)
This Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) does not use a throttle cable.
This throttle position sensor is a non-contact type.
The throttle position sensor is mounted on the throttle body and it detects the opening angle of the throttle
valve. This sensor is electronically controlled and uses Hall-effect elements, so that accurate control and
reliability can be obtained. The throttle position sensor has 2 sensor elements/signal outputs: VTA1 and
VTA2. VTA1 is used to detect the throttle opening angle and VTA2 is used to detect malfunctions in VTA1.
Voltage applied to VTA1 and VTA2 change between 0 V and 5 V in proportion to the opening angle of the
throttle valve. There are several checks that the ECM performs to confirm proper operation of the throttle
position sensor and VTA1.
The ECM judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these signals input from terminals VTA1
and VTA2, and the ECM controls the throttle motor to make the throttle valve angle properly in response to
driver inputs.
Fail-safe Angle
*1
5
VTA2
VTA1
2.58
2.25
0.95
0.69
6.5
Usable Range
0
84
Throttle Valve Opening Angle (deg.)
VTA2
E2
IC No. 2
Magnet
Throttle Valve Fully Closed
(Throttle Position expressed as percentage
(VTA1) 10 to 24 %)
Throttle Valve Fully Opened
(Throttle Position expressed as percentage
(VTA1) 64 to 96 %)
*1: Fail-safe Angle 6.5°
(Throttle Position expressed as percentage
(VTA1) about 16 %)
A19755
A19802
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
293
05-104
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
DTC Detection Condition
Condition (a) of DTC P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222 or P0223 continues
for 2 seconds
(open or short in the throttle position sensor circuit)
Trouble Area
Detection conditions for DTCs P0122 and P0123 are not satisfied but condition (a) is satisfied
(a) VTA1 is 0.2 V or less or VTA1 is 4.8 V or more
Throttle position sensor
ECM
(a) VTA1 is 0.2 V or less
Throttle position sensor
Short in VTA1 circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
P0123
(a) VTA1 is 4.8 V or more
Throttle position sensor
Open in VTA1 circuit
Open in E2 circuit
Short in VC and VTA1 circuits
ECM
P0220
Detection conditions for DTCs P0222 and P0223 are not satisfied but condition (a) is satisfied
(a) VTA2 is 0.5 V or less or VTA2 is 4.8 V or more and
VTA1 is 0.2 V or more and VTA1 is 1.8 V or less
Throttle position sensor
ECM
(a) VTA2 is 0.5 V or less
Throttle position sensor
Short in VTA2 circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
P0223
(a) VTA2 is 4.8 V or more and
VTA1 is 0.2 V or more and VTA1 is 1.8 V or less
Throttle position sensor
Open in VTA2 circuit
Open in E2 circuit
Short in VC and VTA2 circuits
ECM
P2135
Condition (a) continues for 0.5 seconds or more, or
condition (b) continues for 0.4 seconds or more:
(a) Difference between VTA1 and VTA2 is 0.02 V or less
(b) VTA1 is 0.2 V or less and VTA2 is 0.5 V or less
Short in VTA1 and VTA2 circuits
Throttle position sensor
ECM
P0120
P0122
P0222
HINT:
After confirming DTCs, use the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to confirm the throttle valve
opening percentage and closed throttle position switch condition.
”THROTTLE POS” is the VTA1 signal. ”THROTTLE POS #2” is the VTA2 signal.
Reference (Normal condition):
Tester display
Accelerator pedal released
Accelerator pedal fully depressed
THROTTLE POS
10 to 24 %
64 to 96 %
THROTTLE POS #2
2.1 to 3.1 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
294
05-105
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the throttle position sensor to monitor the throttle valve opening angle.
(a) There is a specific voltage difference between VTA1 and VTA2 for each throttle opening angle.
If the difference between VTA1 and VTA2 deviates from the specified range, the ECM interprets this
as a fault and will set a DTC.
(b) VTA1 and VTA2 have each specific voltage operating range.
If VTA1 or VTA2 is out of the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault and will set
a DTC.
(c) VTA1 and VTA2 should never be close to the same voltage levels.
If the difference between VTA1 and VTA2 is within 0.02 V, the ECM interprets this as a short circuit
in the throttle position sensor system and will set a DTC.
FAIL-SAFE
If the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle
control motor. The throttle control valve returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16) by
the force of the return spring. The ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the
vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0120: TP sensor 1 range check (Chattering)
P0122: TP sensor 1 range check (Low voltage)
P0123: TP sensor 1 range check (High voltage)
P0220: TP sensor 2 range check (Chattering)
P0222: TP sensor 2 range check (Low voltage)
P0223: TP sensor 2 range check (High voltage)
P2135: TP sensor range check (Correlation)
Required sensors/components (Main)
TP (Throttle position) sensor
Required sensors/components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
Accelerator pedal ON: 2 seconds
Accelerator pedal OFF: 10 seconds
0.5 seconds or 0.4 seconds (P2135)
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0120:
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less or 4.8 V or more
P0122:
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less
P0123:
VTA1 voltage
4.8 V or more
P0220:
VTA2 voltage
0.5 V or less or 4.8 V or more
P0222:
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
295
05-106
DIAGNOSTICS
VTA2 voltage
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
0.5 V or less
P0223:
VTA2 voltage when the VTA1 is 0.2 to 1.8 V
4.8 V or more
P2135:
Either of the following condition(s) is met:
Condition A or B
Condition A
-
Difference between VTA1 and VTA2 voltages
0.02 V or less
Condition B
-
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less
VTA2 voltage
0.5 V or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VTA1 voltage
0.6 to 3.96 V
VTA2 voltage
2.25 to 4.8 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
T13
Throttle Position Sensor
ECM
5V
18
VC
5
Y
6
B-W
4
B-R
E7
VC
21
VTA1
VTA2
E7
31
E7
Short
Connector
5
5
E2
3
BR
BR
S28
VTA1
VTA2
28
S29
BR
E7
E2
A90295
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs that are related to different systems are output simultaneously while terminal E2 is used as
a ground terminal, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
296
05-107
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Hand-held tester:
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (THROTTLE POS AND THROTTLE POS
#2)
(a)
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST
/ ALL / THROTTLE POS and THROTTLE POS #2. Read the values.
Result:
Throttle position expressed as percentage and voltage
Accelerator pedal released
Accelerator pedal depressed
Trouble Area
Proceed to
THROTTLE POS
(VTA1)
THROTTLE POS #2
(VTA2)
THROTTLE POS
(VTA1)
THROTTLE POS #2
(VTA2)
0%
0 to 0.2 V
0%
0 to 0.2 V
100 %
4.5 to 5.5 V
100 %
4.5 to 5.5 V
E2 circuit open
0 % or 100 %
2.1 to 3.1 V
(fail safe)
0 % or 100 %
2.1 to 3.1 V
(fail safe)
VTA1 circuit open or
ground short
about 16 %
(fail safe)
0 to 0.2 or 4.5 to 5.5 V
about 16 %
(fail safe)
0 to 0.2 or 4.5 to 5.5 V
VTA2 circuit open or
ground short
10 to 24 %
2.1 to 3.1 V
64 to 96 %
(does not fail safe)
4.5 to 5.5 V
(does not fail safe)
Throttle position sensor circuit is normal
B
VC circuit open
A
B
Go to step 5
A
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
T13
Throttle Position Sensor
Disconnect the T13 throttle position sensor connector.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
E2
VTA2
VC
T13-5 (VC) T13-6 (VTA1) T13-4 (VTA2) T13-3 (E2) -
VTA1
E7
ECM
VTA1
Y
B53781
A81699
E7-18
E7-21
E7-31
E7-28
Specified Condition
(VC)
(VTA1)
(VTA2)
(E2)
Below 1 Ω
T13-5 (VC) or E7-18 (VC) - Body ground
T13-6 (VTA1) or E7-21 (VTA1) - Body ground
T13-4 (VTA2) or E7-31 (VTA2) - Body ground
VC
E2
VTA2
A85510
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
10 kΩ or higher
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
297
05-108
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM (VC VOLTAGE)
E7
ECM
(a)
(b)
(c)
VC (+)
Disconnect the T13 throttle position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-18 (VC) - E7-28 (E2)
4.5 to 5.5 V
E2 (-)
A76903
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OK
4
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSY (See page 10-6 )
GO
5
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
READ OUTPUT DTC (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR DTCS ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
Clear the DTC (see page 05-38 ).
Start the engine.
Run the engine at idle for 15 seconds or more.
Read the DTC.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223 and/or P2135 are output again
A
No DTC output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
A
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
298
05-109
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
T13
Throttle Position Sensor
Disconnect the T13 throttle position sensor connector.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
E2
VTA2
VC
T13-5 (VC) T13-6 (VTA1) T13-4 (VTA2) T13-3 (E2) -
VTA1
E7
ECM
E7-18
E7-21
E7-31
E7-28
Specified Condition
(VC)
(VTA1)
(VTA2)
(E2)
Below 1 Ω
T13-5 (VC) or E7-18 (VC) - Body ground
T13-6 (VTA1) or E7-21 (VTA1) - Body ground
T13-4 (VTA2) or E7-31 (VTA2) - Body ground
VC
E2
VTA2
VTA1
Y
B53781
A81699
NG
A85510
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
10 kΩ or higher
HARNESS
AND
OK
2
INSPECT ECM (VC VOLTAGE)
E7
ECM
(a)
(b)
(c)
VC (+)
E2
A76903
Disconnect the T13 throttle position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connector.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-18 (VC) - E7-28 (E2)
4.5 to 5.5 V
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OK
3
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSY (See page 10-6 )
G0
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
299
05-1 10
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
READ OUTPUT DTC (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR DTCS ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
Clear the DTC (see page 05-38 ).
Start the engine.
Run the engine at idle for 15 seconds or more.
Read the DTC.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223 and/or P2135 are output again
A
No DTC output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
A
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
300
05-1 11
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0121
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
052NE-53
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”A” CIRCUIT
RANGE/PERFORMANCE PROBLEM
HINT:
This is the purpose of the ”throttle position sensor”.
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0120 on page 05-102 .
DTC No.
P0121
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Condition (a) continues for 2.0 seconds:
(a) Difference between VTA1 and VTA2 deviates from threshold
Throttle position sensor
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the throttle position sensor to monitor the throttle valve opening angle.
This sensor includes 2 signals: VTA1 and VTA2. VTA1 is used to detect the throttle opening angle and VTA2
is used to detect malfunctions in VTA1. There are several checks that the ECM performs to confirm proper
operation of the throttle position sensor and VTA1.
There is a specific voltage difference between VTA1 and VTA2 for each throttle opening angle.
If the voltage output difference between the VTA1 and VTA2 deviates from the normal operating range, the
ECM interprets this as a malfunction of the throttle position sensor. The ECM will turn on the MIL and will
set a DTC.
FAIL-SAFE
If the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle
control motor. The throttle control valve returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16) by
the force of the return spring. The ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the
vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0121: TP (Throttle position) sensor rationality
Required sensors / components (Main)
TP sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
301
05-1 12
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference in learning voltage value of (VTA1 - VTA2 × 0.8)
Less than 0.8 V, or more than 1.6 V
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
REPLACE THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR (See page 10-6 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
302
05-1 13
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0125
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ESW-05
INSUFFICIENT COOLANT TEMPERATURE
FOR CLOSED LOOP FUEL CONTROL
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 on page 05-95 .
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0125
If ECT (engine coolant temperature) or IAT (intake air temperature) is less than -19.45°C (-3°F) at engine start; 20 minutes or more after starting engine, ECT sensor value is 20°C
(68°F) or less (2 trip detection logic)
If ECT and IAT are between -19.45°C (-3°F) and -8.34°C
(17°F) at engine start; 5 minutes or more after starting engine, ECT sensor value is 20°C (68°F) or less (2 trip detecti logic)
tion
l i )
If ECT and IAT greater than -8.34°C (17°F) at engine start; 2
minutes or more after starting engine, ECT sensor value is
20°C (68°F) or less (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Cooling system
ECT sensor
Thermostat
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to monitor the temperature of the engine coolant.
The resistance of the sensor varies with the actual coolant temperature. The ECM applies a voltage to the
sensor and the varying resistance of the sensor causes the signal voltage to vary. The ECM monitors the
ECT signal voltage after engine start-up. If, after sufficient time has passed, the sensor still reports that the
engine is not warm enough for closed-loop fuel control, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the sensor or
cooling system and sets a DTC.
Example:
The ECT is 0C (32F) at engine start. After 5 minutes running time, the ECT sensor still indicates that the
engine is not warm enough to begin active feedback control of the air-fuel ratio. The ECM interprets this as
a fault in the sensor or cooling system and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0125: Insufficient ECT (Engine coolant temperature) for closed loop
Required sensors/components (Main)
Thermostat, cooling sysem
Required sensors/components (Related)
ECT sensor, MAF meter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 minutes: Engine start ECT is -8.34C (17F) or more
5 minutes: Engine start ECT is -19.45 to -8.34C (-3 to 17F)
20 minutes: Engine start ECT is less than -19.45C (-3F)
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not
present
See page 05-16
Fuel cut
OFF
Engine
Running
Idle
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Time until ”actual ECT” reaches ”Closed Loop ECT”
2 minutes: Engine start ECT is -8.34C (17F) or more
5 minutes: Engine start ECT is -19.45 to -8.34C (-3 to 17F)
20 minutes: Engine start ECT is less than -19.45C (-3F)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
303
05-1 14
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 and P0125 are output simultaneously, engine coolant temperature sensor circuit may be open or short. Perform the troubleshooting of DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118
first.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0125)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
Only P0125 are output
A
P0125 and other DTCs are output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0125 is output, perform the troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-48 )
A
2
(a)
INSPECT THERMOSTAT (See page 16-2 )
Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat.
OK:
Valve opening temperature: 80 to 84C (176 to 183F)
HINT:
Also check that the valve is completely closed under opening temperature as above.
NG
REPLACE THERMOSTAT (See page 16-1 1)
OK
3
(a)
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM
Check the cooling system for excessive cooling, such as abnormal radiator fan operation, modified
cooling system and other defects.
OK:
There is no modification of cooling system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COOLING SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
304
05-1 15
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0128
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ETK-05
COOLANT THERMOSTAT (COOLANT
TEMPERATURE BELOW THERMOSTAT
REGULATING TEMPERATURE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) does not reach 75°C (167°F) despite sufficient engine warm-up time.
DTC No.
P0128
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Thermostat
Cooling system
ECT sensor
ECM
Conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met:
(a) Cold start
(b) Sufficient warm-up time has elapsed
(c) ECT is less than 75°C (167°F)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 seconds
Estimated ECT
Threshold
(75C (167F))
Indicated coolant temperature reading
ECT
Time
DTC set (after 2 driving cycles)
A82385
The ECM estimates the coolant temperature based on starting temperature, engine loads, and engine
speeds. The ECM then compares the estimated temperature with the actual ECT. When the estimated coolant temperature reaches 75C (167F), the ECM checks the actual ECT. If the actual ECT is less than 75C
(167F), the ECM will interpret this as a fault in the thermostat or the engine cooling system and set a DTC.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
305
05-1 16
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0128: Coolant thermostat
Required sensors/components (Main)
Thermostat
Required sensors/components (Related)
ECT sensor, IAT sensor, VSS
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
500 sec.
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. All of the following conditions are met:
Condition (a), (b) and (c)
(a) ECT at engine start - IAT at engine start
-15 to 7C (-27 to 12.6F)
(b) ECT at engine start
-10 to 56C (14 to 132.8F)
(c) IAT at engine start
-10 to 56C (14 to 132.8F)
2. All of the following conditions are met:
Condition (a), (b) and (c)
(a) ECT at engine start - IAT at engine start
More than 7C (12.6F)
(b) ECT at engine start
56C (132.8F) or less
(c) IAT at engine start
-10 C (14F) or more
Accumulated time that vehicle speed is 80 mph (128 km/h)
or more
Less than 20 seconds
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Duration that both of the following conditions 1 and 2 are
met:
5 seconds or more
1. Estimated ECT
120.5C (248.9F) or more
2. ECT sensor output
Less than 120.5C (248.9F)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-24 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-26 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $08: Thermostat
TLT
1
CID
$01
Unit Conversion
Multiply by 0.625 and subtract
40
(C)
Description of Test Data
ECT sensor output when estimated ECT
has reached to malfunction criterion
Description of Test Limit
Malfunction criteria for thermostat
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
306
05-1 17
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM
Check the cooling system for excessive cooling, such as abnormal radiator fan operation, modified
cooling system and other defects.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COOLING SYSTEM
OK
2
(a)
INSPECT THERMOSTAT (See page 16-2 )
Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat.
OK:
Valve opening temperature: 80 to 84C (176 to 183F)
HINT:
Also check that the valve is completely closed under opening temperature as above.
NG
REPLACE THERMOSTAT(See page 16-1 1)
OK
REPLACE ECM(See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
307
05-1 18
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ITJ-02
DTC
P0136
OXYGEN SENSOR CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
(BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
DTC
P0137
OXYGEN SENSOR CIRCUIT LOW VOLTAGE
(BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
DTC
P0138
OXYGEN SENSOR CIRCUIT HIGH VOLTAGE
(BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) is used to monitor oxygen in the exhaust gas. For optimum catalyst operation, the air fuel mixture (air-fuel ratio) must be maintained near the ideal stoichiometric ratio. The HO2S
output voltage changes suddenly in the vicinity of the stoichiometric ratio. The ECM adjusts the fuel injection
time so that the air-fuel ratio is nearly stoichiometric.
The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.1 and 0.9 V in response to oxygen in the exhaust gas. If the oxygen in the exhaust gas increases, the air-fuel ratio becomes Lean. The ECM interprets Lean when the HO2S
voltage is below 0.45 V. If the oxygen in the exhaust gas decreases, the air-fuel ratio becomes Rich. The
ECM interprets Rich when the HO2S voltage is above 0.45 V.
Atmosphere
Ideal Air-fuel Mixture
Platinum Electrode
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Platinum Electrode
Heater
Coating (Ceramic)
Cover
Output Voltage
Housing
Richer - Air Fuel Ratio - Leaner
Exhaust Gas
A90870
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
308
05-1 19
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0136
Following condition (a) (b) or (c) is met:
(a) During driving with engine warmed up, heated oxygen sensor output does not change for 8 minutes
(b) Heated oxygen sensor output
out ut is very low most of time for
220 seconds
(c) The rear heated oxygen sensor voltage does not drop to
below 0.2 V immediately when vehicle decelerates and fuel
cut is o
operating
erating
Both (a) and (b) continue for more than 30 seconds:
(a) Estimated rear oxygen sensor temperature is less than
800C
(b) Rear oxygen sensor impedance is less than 5Ω
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
circuit
i i
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 2)
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
P0137
Both (a) and (b) continue for more than 240 seconds:
(a) Estimated rear oxygen sensor temperature is more than
450C
(b) Rear oxygen sensor impedance is more than 15kΩ
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
circuit (sensor to ECM)
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
internal
P0138
Rear oxygen sensor output voltage is over 1.2 V for more than
30 seconds
Short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) circuit
Short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) circuit
ECM internal circuit malfunction
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the rear heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) in the following 4 items:
1. The HO2S voltage changes between Rich (more than 0.45 V) and Lean (less than 0.45 V) while the vehicle
is running (repeating acceleration and deceleration) for 8 minutes. If not, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction, illuminates the MIL, and then sets a DTC.
2. The HO2S voltage does not remain at less than 0.05 V for a long time while the vehicle is running (60 %
of the time in the 220 second-monitor, the sensor output is less than 0.05 V). If it does, the ECM interprets
this as a malfunction, illuminates the MIL, and then sets a DTC.
3. The sensor’s voltage drops to below 0.2 V (extremely Lean status) immediately when the vehicle decelerates and the fuel cut is working for 7 seconds. If not, the ECM interprets this to mean the sensor’s response
feature has deteriorated, illuminates the MIL, and then sets a DTC.
4. The rear oxygen sensor impedance is 5 Ω or less, 15 kΩ or more, or output voltage is 1.2 V or more (normal
voltage: 0 to 1.0 V). If so, the ECM will determine that the rear oxygen sensor or a related circuit has an open
or short circuit, illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
Impedance is detected by the IC inside the ECM.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0136: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Output voltage)
P0136: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Low impedance)
P0137: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (High impedance)
P0138: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (High voltage)
P0138: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (During fuel-cut)
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
Heated oxygen sensor
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor, engine coolant temperature sensor, mass air flow meter and throttle position sensor
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle: Active air-fuel ratio control detection
Continuous: Others
Duration
Within 480 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles: P0136 (Rear HO2S output voltage - case 1)
P0136 (Rear HO2S output voltage - case 2)
P0138 (Rear HO2S voltage during fuel-cut)
Immediate: Others
Sequence of Operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
309
05-120
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
P0136 (Rear HO2S output voltage - case 1):
All of the following conditions are met:
Conditions 1, 2, 3 and 4
1. Malfunction determination in this driving cycle
Not detected
2. Engine
Running
3. Time after engine start
0 second or more
4. Either of the following conditions is met:
Conditions (a) or (b)
(a) Cumulative time while HO2S heater is operating
22 seconds or more
(b) HO2S voltage
Has reached to 0.2 V or more
P0136 (Rear HO2S output voltage - case 2):
Engine
Running
P0136 (Rear HO2S low impedance):
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Estimated HO2S temperature
Less than 700C (1,292F)
ECM monitor
Completed
P0606
Not set
P0137 (Rear HO2S high impedance):
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Estimated HO2S temperature
450C (842F) or higher
ECM monitor
Completed
P0606
Not set
P0138 (Rear HO2S output voltage - case 3):
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Time after engine start
2 seconds or more
P0138 (Rear HO2S output voltage during fuel-cut):
Engine coolant temperature
70C (158F) or more
Catalyst temperature
400C (752F) or more
Fuel-cut
Executing
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0136 (Rear HO2S output voltage - case 1):
Both of the following conditions are met:
Conditions 1 and 2
1. Frequency that HO2S voltage changes between (a) and
(b)
0 time
(a) Maximum voltage
0.6 V or more
(b) Minimum voltage
2. Cumulative monitor time
Less than 0.45 V
*1 of
rear HO2S
320 seconds or more
*1: Monitor time is counted when all of the following conditions are met:
Conditions (a) and (b)
(a) Fuel system status
Closed-loop
(b) Idle
OFF
P0136 (Rear HO2S output voltage - case 2):
All of the following conditions are met:
Conditions 1, 2, 3, 4 and 5
1. Cumulative monitor time *2 of HO2S
220 seconds or more
2. Duration while HO2S voltage is below 0.05 V
132 seconds or more
3. Duration while HO2S voltage is higher than 0.7 V
Less than 44 seconds
4. Duration while HO2S voltage is 0.45 V to 0.7 V
Less than 88 seconds
5. Duration while HO2S voltage is 0.45 V or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Less than 20 seconds
Author:
Date:
310
05-121
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
*2: Monitor time is counted when all of the following conditions are met:
Conditions 1, 2, 3 and 4
1. Intake air amount per revolution
0.32 g/rev or more
2. Vehicle speed
3 km/h (1.875 mph) or more
3. Idle
OFF
4. Fuel-cut
OFF
P0136 (Rear HO2S low impedance):
Duration of the following condition:
30 seconds or more
Rear HO2S impedance
Less than 5 Ω
P0137 (Rear HO2S high impedance):
Duration of the following condition:
90 seconds or more
Rear HO2S impedance
15 kΩ or more
P0138 (Rear HO2S output voltage - case 3):
Duration of the following condition:
10 seconds or more
Rear HO2S voltage
1.2 V or more
P0138 (Rear HO2S output voltage during fuel-cut):
Either of the following conditions is met:
Conditions 1 or 2
1. Duration until rear HO2S voltage drops to 0.2 V after fuelcut start
7 seconds or more
2. Both of the following conditions are met:
Conditions (a) and (b)
(a) Rear HO2S voltage when fuel-cut starts
0.5 V or more
(b) Duration that HO2S voltage is 0.2 to 0.35 V
1 second or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
HO2S voltage
Varies between 0.1 and 0.9 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
311
05-122
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
O2S TEST RESULT
Refer to page 05-22 for detailed information.
HO2S Output voltage (Minimum and Maximum):
TEST ID
Description of TEST
VALUE
Conversion Factor (Unit)
Unit
Standard Value
$07
Minimum HO2S voltage
N/A
V
Less than TEST LIMIT
$08
Maximum HO2S voltage
N/A
V
More than TEST LIMIT
$31
Minimum time per onecycle of HO2S frequency
that HO2S switches Lean
to Rich
N/A
Second
Less than TEST LIMIT
$32
Minimum time per onecycle of HO2S frequency
that HO2S switches Rich
to Lean
N/A
Second
Less than TEST LIMIT
$37
Time until HO2S voltage
drops to 0.2 V during fuelcut
N/A
Second
Less than TEST LIMIT
$81
Percentage in monitoring
time while HO2S voltage is
lower than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.39
%
Less than TEST LIMIT
$84
Percentage in monitoring
time while HO2S voltage is
higher than 0.7 V
Multiply 0.39
%
More than TEST LIMIT
$85
Continuous time while
HO2S voltage is higher
than 0.45 V
Multiply 0.262
Second
More than TEST LIMIT
$87
Percentage in monitoring
time while HO2S voltage is
higher than 0.45 V
Multiply 0.39
%
More than TEST LIMIT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
312
05-123
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
H10
Heated Oxygen Sensor
5
B-R
IM1
GR
1 EB1
1 +B
HT 2
3 E
OX 4
6
BR
Shielded
B
IM1
R-Y
21
HT1B
E8
G
29
E8 OX1B
3
IM1
B-W
2
2
W
2
EFI
NO. 2
1
Engine
Room R/B
No. 2
P-L
IM1
13
IK3
2
R
E8 O1B8
MREL
E5
B
2
Y
3
2D
5
3
2B
Engine
Room
J/B
1
R
EFI
Relay
5
EFI
NO. 1
2
4
IM1
BR
1
F7
FL
Block
Assy
2I
W
3
4
2F
A
J7
J/C
W-B
A
BR
1
E9
E1
A
A
1
W
J2
J/C
BR
FL
Main
Battery
EH
EE
A90296
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
313
05-124
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (P0136)
Once
40 seconds
or more
Vehicle speed
60 km/h
(38 mph)
Twice
40 seconds
or more
(d)
Idling (c)
12 times
40 seconds
or more
(d)
(e)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Ignition Switch OFF
Warm up
10 seconds
(a), (b) (engine coolant
or more
temperature
is more than 75C (167F))
10 seconds
or more
10 seconds
or more
A58686
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Switch the hand-held tester from normal mode to check (test) mode (see page 05-40 ).
(c) Start the engine and warm it up until the engine coolant temperature becomes more than 75C.
(d) Drive the vehicle at 60 km/h (38 mph) or more for 40 seconds or more.
(e) Let the engine idle for 10 seconds or more.
(f)
Perform steps (d) to (e) 12 times.
HINT:
If a malfunction exists, the MIL will illuminate during step (f).
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of a malfunction will not occur. If you
do not have a hand-held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after performing steps from (c) to (f), then
perform steps from (c) to (f) again.
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (P0137)
Warm up the engine and run the engine at 60 km/h (38 mph) for 7 minutes.
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (P0138)
Warm up the engine and run the engine at idle for 30 seconds.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
It is possible the malfunctioning area can be found using the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation. The
A/F CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential trouble
areas are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume 12.5 % or increases the injection volume 25 %.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(5) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine idle (press the right or left button).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
314
05-125
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → rich output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5 % → lean output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → rich output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5 % → lean output: Less than 0.4 V
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Output voltage of A/F sensor
(sensor 1)
Output voltage of heated oxygen
sensor (sensor 2)
Injection volume
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 1 Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
OK
More than 0.55 V
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 2 Output voltage
A/F sensor
(A/F sensor, heater, A/F sensor circuit)
Output voltage
NG
Injection volume
More than 0.55 V
OK
Less than 0.4V
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 3 Output voltage
NG
Heated oxygen sensor
(heated oxygen sensor,
heater, heated oxygen sensor
circuit)
NG
Extremely rich or lean actual
air-fuel ratio
(Injector, fuel pressure, gas
leakage in exhaust system,
etc.)
Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
OK
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 4 Output voltage
Almost
No reaction
OK
Less than 0.4V
+25 %
Less than 3.0V
Output voltage
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Main suspect
trouble area
Output voltage
NG
Almost
No reaction
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables a technician to check and graph the voltage outputs of both
the A/F sensor and the heated oxygen sensor.
For displaying the graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2” by pressing ”YES” and push ”ENTER”. Then press ”F4”.
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
315
05-126
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT
(a)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0138 is output
A
P0137 is output
B
P0136 is output
C
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0136, P0137 and/or P138 are output, perform the troubleshooting for those
codes first.
B
Go to step 9
C
Go to step 6
A
2
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (OUTPUT
VOLTAGE OF HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Turn ON the ignition switch. Push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / O2S B1S2.
Run the engine at idle.
Read the output voltage of the heated oxygen sensor during idling.
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage
Proceed to
More than 1.2 V
A
Less than 1.0 V
B
B
READ OUTPUT DTC
A
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CHECK FOR SHORT)
(a)
(b)
(c)
E8
ECM
Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for 5 minutes.
Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
O1BOX1B
HT1B
A81695
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8-21 (HT1B) - E8-29 (OX1B)
10 kΩ or higher
E8-21 (HT1B) - E8-2 (O1B-)
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
316
05-127
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (CHECK FOR SHORT)
(a)
(b)
H10
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Disconnect the H10 heated oxygen sensor connector.
Measure the resistance of the sensor side connectors.
Standard:
+B
OX
E1
OK
A80018
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H10-1 (+B) - H10-3 (E1)
10 kΩ or higher
H10-1 (+B) - H10-4 (OX)
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
5
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (CHECK MODE)
Change the ECM to check mode with the hand-held tester.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / CHECK MODE.
Warm up the engine and drive the vehicle at over 25 mph (40 km/h) for an accumulated total of 10
minutes.
(b)
HINT:
The 10 minutes of driving should be driven in one instance, but it is not necessary to maintain a speed of
25 mph (40 km/h) for 10 minutes consecutively.
(c) Read the DTC.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P0136 is output
A
No DTC
B
B
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
A
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
6
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (OUTPUT
VOLTAGE OF HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR)
(a) After warming up the engine, run the engine at 2,500 rpm for 3 minutes.
(b) Read the output voltage of the heated oxygen sensor when the engine rpm is suddenly increased.
HINT:
Quickly accelerate the engine to 4,000 rpm 3 times by using the accelerator pedal.
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage: Alternates 0.4 V or less and 0.5 V or more.
OK
Go to step 10
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
317
05-128
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
H10
Heated Oxygen Sensor
HT
+B
Disconnect the H10 heated oxygen sensor connector.
Measure the resistance of the heated oxygen sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
OX
E1
Condition
Specified Condition
H10-1 (+B) - H10-2 (HT)
20C (68F)
11 to 16 Ω
H10-1 (+B) - H10-2 (HT)
800C (1,472F)
23 to 32 Ω
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
A80018
OK
8
INSPECT RELAY (EFI)
1
3
1
5
2
2
5
(a)
(b)
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
318
05-129
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(a)
Wire Harness Side
H10
Heated Oxygen Sensor
+B
HT
E1
OX
Check the wire harness between the ECM and heated oxygen sensor.
(1) Disconnect the H10 heated oxygen sensor connector.
(2) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
E8
ECM
OX1B
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H10-2 (HT) - E8-21 (HT1B)
H10-4 (OX) - E8-29 (OX1B)
Below 1 Ω
H10-2 (HT) or E8-21 (HT1B) - Body ground
H10-4 (OX) or E8-29 (OX1B) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HT1B
A80019
A81695
A92146
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 2 System Drawing)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
EFI Relay
From
Battery
EFI NO. 1
Fuse
ECM
+B Heater HT
HT1B
EFI NO. 2
Sensor
E1
Fuse
OX
OX1B
Duty
Control
OB1MREL
A90346
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
319
05-130
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
10
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern.
GO
11
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (DTC P0136 IS OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0136 is not output again
A
P0136 is output again
B
A
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
B
12
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
GO
13
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern.
GO
14
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (DTC P0136 IS OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0136 is not output again
A
P0136 is output again
B
A
REPAIR COMPLETED
B
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
320
05-131
DIAGNOSTICS
15
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER
Start the engine and warm it up.
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn ON the ignition switch and the hand-held tester main switch.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / INJ VOL.
Using the hand-held tester, change the injection volume to check the A/F sensor output and heated
oxygen sensor output values below.
HINT:
Change the injection volume from -12.5 % to +12.5 %.
Result:
A/F sensor output remains more than 3.3 V or A/F sensor output remains less than 3.3 V
(Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume)
Injection Volume
+12.5 %
-12.5 %
Malfunction
A/F Sensor Output
Normal
3.3 V
Heated Oxygen Sensor Output
Malfunction
1V
0
A87979
OK
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE EXTREMLY RICH OR LEAN ACTUAL AIR FUEL RATIO (INJECTOR, FUEL
PRESSURE, GAS LEAKAGE IN EXHAUST SYSTEM, ETC.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
321
05-132
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ETQ-06
DTC
P0171
SYSTEM TOO LEAN (BANK 1)
DTC
P0172
SYSTEM TOO RICH (BANK 1)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The fuel trim is related to the feedback compensation value, not to the basic injection time. The fuel trim includes the short-term fuel trim and the long-term fuel trim.
The short-term fuel trim is the short-term fuel compensation used to maintain the ideal stoichiometric airfuel ratio. The signal from the A/F sensor indicates whether the air-fuel ratio is RICH or LEAN compared
to the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio. This variance triggers a reduction in the fuel volume if the air-fuel ratio
is RICH, and an increase in the fuel volume if it is LEAN.
The short-term fuel trim varies from the central value due to individual engine differences, wear over time
and changes in the operating environment. The long-term fuel trim, which controls overall fuel compensation, steadies long-term deviations of the short-term fuel trim from the central value.
If both the short-term fuel trim and the long-term fuel trim are LEAN or RICH beyond a certain value, it is
detected as a malfunction, the MIL is illuminated and a DTC is set.
DTC No.
P0171
P0172
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
When air-fuel ratio feedback is stable after warming up engine,
fuel trim is considerably in error on LEAN side
(2 trip detection logic)
Air induction system
Injector blockage
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 1)
EFI relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and EFI relay circuits
PCV hose connection
PCV hose
When air-fuel ratio feedback is stable after warming up engine,
fuel trim is considerably in error on RICH side
(2 trip detection logic)
Injector leak, blockage
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Ignition system
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and EFI relay circuits
EFI relay
HINT:
When DTC P0171 is recorded, the actual air-fuel ratio is on the LEAN side. When DTC P0172 is recorded, the actual air-fuel ratio is on the RICH side.
If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the air-fuel ratio is LEAN and DTC P0171 is recorded. The MIL then illuminates.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
322
05-133
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
+34 (%): Threshold at LEAN
1.35
Fuel Compensation
Amount
1.0
-34 (%): Threshold at RICH
0.65
A82386
Under closed-loop fuel control, fuel injection amounts that deviate from the ECM’s estimated fuel amount
will cause a change in the long-term fuel trim compensation value. This long-term fuel trim is adjusted when
there are persistent deviations in the short-term fuel trim values. And, the deviation from the simulated fuel
injection amount by the ECM affects the smoothed fuel trim learning value. The smoothed fuel trim learning
value is the combination of smoothed short-term fuel trim (fuel feedback compensation value) and
smoothed long-term fuel trim (learning value of the air-fuel ratio). When the smoothed fuel trim learning value exceeds the DTC threshold, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the fuel system and sets a DTC.
Example:
The smoothed fuel trim learning value is more than +34 % or less than -34 %. The ECM interprets this as
a failure in the fuel system.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0171: Fuel System Lean
P0172: Fuel System Rich
Required sensors/ components (Main)
Fuel system
Required sensors / components (Related)
A/F sensor, MAF meter, CKP sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 sec.
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
323
05-134
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Fuel system status
Closed Loop
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Engine RPM
Less than 1,100 rpm
2. Intake air amount per revolution
0.22 g/rev or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Purge-cut
Excecuting
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Average between short-term fuel trim and long-term fuel
trim
34% or more (varies with ECT)
2. Average between short-term fuel trim and long-term fuel
trim
-34% or less (varies with ECT)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-269 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
It is possible the malfunctioning area can be found using the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation. The
A/F CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential trouble
areas are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume by 12.5 % or increases the injection volume by
25 %.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(5) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine idling (press the right or left button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: Less than 0.4 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
324
05-135
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Output voltage of A/F sensor
(sensor 1)
Output voltage of heated oxygen
sensor (sensor 2)
Injection volume
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 1 Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
OK
More than 0.55 V
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 2 Output voltage
A/F sensor
(A/F sensor, heater, A/F sensor circuit)
Output voltage
NG
Injection volume
More than 0.55 V
OK
Less than 0.4V
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 3 Output voltage
Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
OK
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
NG
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 4 Output voltage
Almost
No reaction
OK
Less than 0.4V
+25 %
Less than 3.0V
Output voltage
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Main suspect
trouble area
Output voltage
NG
Almost
No reaction
NG
Heated oxygen sensor
(heated oxygen sensor,
heater, heated oxygen sensor
circuit)
Extremely rich or lean actual
air-fuel ratio
(Injector, fuel pressure, gas
leakage in exhaust system,
etc.)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables a technician to check and graph the voltage outputs of both
the A/F sensor and the heated oxygen sensor.
For displaying the graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2” by pressing ”YES” and push ”ENTER”. Then press ”F4”.
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a RICH air fuel mixture. Check the conditions that might
cause the engine to run with a RICH air fuel mixture.
A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a LEAN air fuel mixture. Check the conditions that might
cause the engine to run with a LEAN air fuel mixture.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
325
05-136
DIAGNOSTICS
1
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Check for vacuum leaks in air induction system.
OK: No vacuum leak.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF PCV HOSE
OK: PCV hose is connected correctly and PCV hose is not damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
3
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (INJECTION AND VOLUME) (See page 11-4 )
Standard:
Injection Volume
Difference Between Each Injector
76 to 91 cm3 (4.6 to 5.5 cu in.) / 15 seconds
15 cm3 (0.9 cu in.) or less
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
(See page 11-10 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
326
05-137
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT MASS AIR FLOW METER
(a)
(b)
Air
E2
THA
5
VG
+B
EVG
4 3 2 1
(c)
30
20
10
Resistance kΩ
5
Remove the MAF meter.
Check the output voltage.
(1) Apply battery voltage across terminals +B and
EVG.
(2) Connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal
VG, and negative (-) tester probe to terminal EVG.
(3) Blow air into the MAF meter, and check that the voltage fluctuates.
Measure the resistance of the IAT terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
4 (THA) - 5 (E2)
-20 C (-4F)
13.6 to 18.4 kΩ
4 (THA) - 5 (E2)
20C (68F)
2.21 to 2.69 kΩ
4 (THA) - 5 (E2)
60C (140F)
0.49 to 0.67 kΩ
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
Acceptable
0.1
-20
(-4)
0 20 40 60 80 100
(32) (80) (104) (140)(176) (212)
TemperatureC(F)
A60548
NG
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
327
05-138
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
Ohmmeter
Remove the ECT sensor.
Measure the resistance of the ECT sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
20C (68F)
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ
1-2
80C (176F)
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ
30
20
10
5
Resistance kΩ
Acceptable
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
-20
S01196
S01699
(-4)
0
20 40 60 80 100
(32) (68) (104) (140) (176) (212)
Temperature C (F)
NOTICE:
When checking the ECT sensor in water, be careful not to
allow water to go into the terminals. After the check, dry the
sensor.
HINT:
Alternate procedure: Connect an ohmmeter to the installed
ECT sensor and read the resistance. Use an infrared thermometer to measure the engine temperature in the immediate vicinity of the sensor. Compare these values to the resistance/temperature graph. Change the engine temperature (warm up or
allow to cool down) and repeat the test.
NG
A81700
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
OK
6
CHECK FOR SPARK AND IGNITION (See page 18-1 )
OK: Spark occurs.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
OK
7
(a)
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE (See page 11-4 )
Check the fuel pressure (high or low pressure).
Standard:
Item
Specified Condition
Fuel pressure
304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 55 psi)
NG
REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
328
05-139
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
OK: No gas leak.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE EXHAUST
LEAKAGE POINT (See page 15-2 )
GAS
OK
9
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (OUTPUT
VOLTAGE OF AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (BANK 1 SENSOR 1))
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Warm up the A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90
seconds.
Read A/F sensor voltage output on the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Hand-held tester only:
Enter the following menus: ENHANCED OBD II / SNAPSHOT / MANUAL SNAPSHOT / USER DATA.
Select ”AFS B1 S1 / ENGINE SPD” and press YES.
Monitor the A/F sensor voltage carefully.
Check the A/F sensor voltage output under the following conditions:
(1) Allow the engine to idle for 30 seconds.
(2) Running the engine at approximately 2,500 rpm (where engine RPM is not suddenly changed).
(3) Raise the engine speed to 4,000 rpm and quickly release the accelerator pedal so that the throttle
is fully closed.
Standard:
Condition (1) and (2)
Voltage change of 3.3 V (0.66 V)* (between approximately 3.1 to 3.5 V), as shown in the illustration.
Condition (3)
A/F sensor voltage increases to 3.8 V (0.76 V)* or more when fuel is cut during engine deceleration, as shown in the illustration.
*: Voltage when using the OBD II scan tool.
Normal Condition
Malfunction Condition
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(1) Idle
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
A/F
Sensor
Voltage
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
Engine
RPM
Engine
RPM
”Condition (3)”
3.8 V or More
A/F
Sensor
Voltage
Fuel Cut
”Condition (1), (2)”
Change of approximately 3.3 V
Fuel Cut
When A/F sensor circuit is malfunctioning,
voltage output does not change
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
A72304
Author:
Date:
329
05-140
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
HINT:
Whenever the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at approximately 3.3 V (0.660 V)* (see ”Malfunction Condition” graphic) under any condition as well as the above conditions, the A/F sensor may
have an open circuit (this will happen also when the A/F sensor heater has an open circuit).
Whenever the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at a certain value of approximately 3.8 V (0.76
V)* or more, or 2.8 V (0.56 V)* or less (see ”Malfunction Condition” graphic) under any condition as
well as the above conditions, the A/F sensor may have a short circuit.
The ECM will stop fuel injection (fuel cut) during engine deceleration. This will cause a LEAN condition
and should result in a momentary increase in A/F sensor voltage output.
The ECM must establish a closed throttle position learned value to perform fuel cut. If the battery terminal has been disconnected, the vehicle must be driven over 10 mph (16 km/h) to allow the ECM to learn
the closed throttle position.
When the vehicle is driven:
You may notice that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is below 2.8 V (0.76 V)* during fuel enrichment. For example, when the vehicle tries to overtake another vehicle on a highway, the vehicle speed
is suddenly increased with the accelerator pedal fully depressed. The A/F sensor is functioning normally.
The A/F sensor is a current output element, and therefore the current is converted into voltage inside
the ECM. If measuring voltage at connectors of A/F sensor or ECM, you will observe a constant voltage.
*: Voltage when using the OBD II scan tool.
OK
Go to step 17
NG
10
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
A6
A/F sensor
AF-
AF+
A52607
Disconnect the A6 A/F sensor connector.
Measure the resistance of the A/F sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
20C (68F)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
-
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Specified Condition
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
330
05-141
DIAGNOSTICS
11
1
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT RELAY (EFI)
1
3
-
5
2
2
5
(a)
(b)
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
331
05-142
DIAGNOSTICS
12
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
A6
A/F Sensor
HT
1
3
2
4
AF+
+B
Disconnect the A6 A/F sensor connector.
Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A6-3 (AF+) - E8-23 (A1A+)
A6-4 (AF-) - E8-31 (A1A-)
A6-1 (HT) - E8-5 (HA1A)
Below 1 Ω
A6-3 (AF+) or E8-23 (A1A+) - Body ground
A6-4 (AF-) or E8-31 (A1A-) - Body ground
A6-1 (HT) or E8-5 (HA1A) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AFE8
ECM
A1A+
HA1A
A1A-
Y
A76787
A81695
A85512
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Drawing)
EFI Relay
From
Battery
EFI NO. 1
Fuse
ECM
A/F Sensor
Heater
HT
+B
HA1A
EFI NO. 2
Sensor
Fuse AFAF+
A1A+
Duty
Control
A1AMREL
A90346
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
13
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
332
05-143
DIAGNOSTICS
14
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
(e)
38 to 75 mph
(60 to 120 km/h)
Idling
IG SW OFF
(d)
2 minutes
3 to 5 minutes
(a), (b), (c)
Time
A79199
(a)
Clear the DTCs.
(1) Disconnect the battery cable or remove the EFI NO. 1 and ETCS fuses for 60 seconds or more.
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Switch the hand-held tester from the normal mode to the check mode (see page 05-40 ).
Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessory switches OFF.
Drive the vehicle at 38 to 75 mph (60 to 120 km/h) and engine speed at 1,400 to 3,200 rpm for 3 to
5 minutes.
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
HINT:
If a malfunction exists, the MIL will be illuminated during step (e).
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detecting a malfunction may be difficult. If you
do not have a hand-held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after performing steps (d) to (e), and then
do step (e) again.
GO
15
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (DTC P0171, P0172 ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
DTC P0171, P0172 are not output again
A
DTC P0171, P0172 are output again
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 ) AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(Refer to step 14)
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
333
05-144
DIAGNOSTICS
16
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
YES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL (DTCS P0171, P0172)
17
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern (refer to step 14).
GO
18
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (DTC P0171, P0172 ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
DTC P0171, P0172 are output again
A
DTC P0171, P0172 are not output again
B
B
Go to step 22
A
19
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
20
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern (refer to step 14).
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
334
05-145
DIAGNOSTICS
21
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
READ OUTPUT DTC (DTC P0171, P0172 ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
DTC P0171, P0172 are not output again
A
DTC P0171, P0172 are output again
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 ) AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(Refer to step 14)
A
22
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
YES
DTC IS CAUSED SHORTAGE OF FUEL (DTCS P0171, P0172)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
335
05-146
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ETT-05
DTC
P0300
RANDOM/MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE
DETECTED
DTC
P0301
CYLINDER 1 MISFIRE DETECTED
DTC
P0302
CYLINDER 2 MISFIRE DETECTED
DTC
P0303
CYLINDER 3 MISFIRE DETECTED
DTC
P0304
CYLINDER 4 MISFIRE DETECTED
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When a misfire occurs in the engine, hydrocarbons (HC) are output in high concentrations. If this HC concentration is high enough, there could be an increase in exhaust emission levels. High concentrations of HC
can also cause the temperature of the catalyst to increase, possibly damaging the catalyst. To prevent increases in emissions and limit the possibility of thermal damage, the ECM monitors the misfire rate. When
the temperature of the catalyst reaches a point of thermal degradation, the ECM will blink the MIL. For monitoring misfires, the ECM uses both the camshaft position sensor and the crankshaft position sensor. The
camshaft position sensor is used to identify misfiring cylinders and the crankshaft position sensor is used
to measure variations in the crankshaft rotation speed. A misfire is counted when crankshaft rotation speed
variations exceed threshold values.
If the misfiring rate exceeds the threshold value and could cause emission deterioration, the ECM illuminates
the MIL.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
336
05-147
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0300
Misfiring of random cylinders is detected
Open or short in engine wire
Connector connection
Vacuum hose connection
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel pressure
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Compression pressure
Valve clearance
Valve timing
PCV hose connection
PCV hose
ECM
P0301
P0302
P0303
P0304
Misfiring of each cylinder is detected
Same as DTC No.
No P0300
HINT:
When several codes for a misfiring cylinder are recorded repeatedly but no random misfire code is recorded,
the misfires have been detected and recorded at different times.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
ECM
Camshaft Position Sensor
Crankshaft Position Sensor
(36-2 teeth or 12 teeth)
A90871
The ECM illuminates the MIL (2 trip detection logic) if:
The misfiring rate exceeds a threshold value and could cause emission deterioration.
During the first 1,000 engine revolutions after the engine starts, an excessive misfire rate (approximately 20 to 50 misfires per 1,000 engine revolutions) occurs 1 time.
After the first 1,000 engine revolutions after the engine starts, an excessive misfire rate (approximately
20 to 50 misfires per 1,000 engine revolutions) occurs 4 times.
The ECM blinks the MIL (MIL blinks immediately) if:
Within 200 engine revolutions at a high rpm, the threshold for ”percentage of misfire causing catalyst
damage” is reached 1 time.
Within 200 engine revolutions at a normal rpm, the threshold for ”percentage of misfire causing catalyst
damage” is reached 3 times. (for the 2nd trip, reaching the threshold once will cause the MIL to flash)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
337
05-148
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0300: Multiple cylinder misfire
P0301: cylinder 1 misfire
P0302: cylinder 2 misfire
P0303: cylinder 3 misfire
P0304: cylinder 4 misfire
Required sensors / components (Main)
Injector, ignition coil, spark plug
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP, CMP, ECT, IAT and MAF meter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
1,000 revolutions: Emission-related-misfire
200 revolutions: Catalyst-damaged-misfire
MIL operation
2 driving cycles (MIL flashes immediately when Catalyst-damaged-misfire occurs)
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
VVT system
Not operated by scan tool
Engine RPM
400 to 6,200 rpm
All of the following conditions are met:
Condition 1 and 2
1. Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT)
-10 C (14F) or more
2. Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition (a) or (b)
(a) ECT at engine start
More than -7C (19.4F)
(b) ECT
More than 20C (68F)
Fuel-cut
OFF
Monitor Period of Emission-related-misfire:
First 1,000 revolutions after engine start, or check mode
Crankshaft 1,000 revolutions
Except above
Crankshaft 1,000 revolutions × 4
Monitor Period of Catalyst-damage-misfire (MIL blinks):
All of the following conditions 1, 2 and 3 met:
Crankshaft 200 revolutions
1. Driving cycles
1st
2. Check Mode
OFF
3. Engine RPM
Less than 3,800 rpm
Except above
Crankshaft 200 revolutions x 3
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Monitor Period of Emission-related-misfire:
Misfire rate
4.0 % or more
Monitor Period of Catalyst-damage-misfire (MIL blinks):
Number of misfire per 200 revolutions
129 or more (varies with intake air amount and engine RPM)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
338
05-149
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0351 on page 05-174 for the wiring diagram of the ignition system.
ECM
5
6
R
IC3
LG
EB1
I8
Injector No. 1
R
L
1
2
R
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
9
1G
IG2
R
4
1C
1
1
1C
1G
B
R
I15
Ignition Switch
GR
E7
#1
2
E7
#2
3
E7
#3
4
E7
#4
W-B
7
E7
E01
W-B
6
E02
E7
I10
Injector No. 3
R
B
2
1
AM2 7
6 IG2
R
Y
1
L-Y
I9
Injector No. 2
R
Y
1
2
1
IC1
I11
Injector No. 4
R
W
1
2
10
AM2
F7
FL Block Assy
1
W
FL
Main
Battery
EF
A90297
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
339
05-150
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Record the DTCs, freeze frame data and misfire counter data.
Set the hand-held tester to check mode (see page 05-40 ).
Read the value on the misfire counter for each cylinder when idling. If the value is displayed on the
misfire counter, skip the following procedure of confirmation driving.
(e) Drive the vehicle several times with the engine speed, load and its surrounding range shown with ENGINE SPD, CALC LOAD in the freeze frame data or MISFIRE RPM, MISFIRE LOAD in the DATA LIST.
If you have no hand-held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after the symptom is simulated once. Then repeat the simulation process again.
HINT:
In order to memorize the misfire DTC, it is necessary to drive with MISFIRE RPM, MISFIRE LOAD in the
DATA LIST for the period of time in the chart below. Take care not to turn the ignition switch OFF. Turning
the ignition switch OFF switches the diagnosis system from check mode to normal mode and all DTCs,
freeze frame data and other data are erased.
(f)
(g)
Engine Speed
Time
Idling
3 minutes 30 seconds or more
1,000 rpm
3 minutes or more
2,000 rpm
1 minute 30 seconds or more
3,000 rpm
1 minute or more
Check if there is misfire or not by monitoring, DTC and the freeze frame data. Record the DTCs, freeze
frame data and misfire counter data.
Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for at least 5 seconds.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs besides misfire DTCs are memorized simultaneously, troubleshoot the non-misfire DTCs first.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
If the misfire does not occur when the vehicle is brought to the workshop, the misfire can be confirmed
by reproducing the condition of the freeze frame data. Also, after finishing the repair, confirm that there
is no misfire (see confirmation driving pattern).
On 6 and 8 cylinder engines, cylinder specific misfire fault codes are disabled at high engine speeds.
If the misfire starts in a high engine speed area or the misfire occurs only in a high engine speed area,
only the general fault code P0300 will be stored.
When only a general misfire fault code like P0300 is stored:
(1) Erase the general misfire fault code from the ECM using the hand-held tester or OBD II scan
tool.
(2) Start the engine and drive the confirmation pattern.
(3) Read the value of the misfire ratio for each cylinder. Or read the DTC.
(4) Perform repairs on the cylinder that has a high misfire ratio. Or repair the cylinder indicated by
the DTC.
(5) After finishing repairs, drive the confirmation pattern again and confirm that no misfire occurs.
When either of SHORT FT #1, LONG FT #1 in the freeze frame data is over the range of ±20 %, there
is a possibility that the air-fuel ratio is becoming to RICH (-20 % or less) or LEAN (+20 % or more).
When COOLANT TEMP in the freeze frame data is less than 80°C (176°F), there is a possibility of
misfire only during engine warm-up.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
340
05-151
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
If the misfire cannot be reproduced, the following reasons may apply: 1) the vehicle has low fuel, 2)
improper fuel is being used, and 3) the ignition plug is contaminated.
Be sure to check the value on the misfire counter after the repair.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO MISFIRE DTCS)
(a)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester to the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
Only P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 are output
A
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 and other DTCs are output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 are output, perform the troubleshooting
for those codes first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-48 )
A
2
(a)
(b)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS, CONNECTOR AND VACUUM HOSE IN ENGINE ROOM
Check the connection conditions of the wire harness and connector.
Check for the disconnection, piping and break of the vacuum hose.
OK: Connected correctly and no damage on wire harness.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE, THEN CONFIRM THAT
THERE IS NO MISFIRE
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTION OF PCV HOSE
OK: PCV hose is connected correctly and PCV hose has no damage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
341
05-152
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (NUMBER OF
MISFIRE)
(a) Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
(b) Turn ON the ignition switch. Push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
(c) Start the engine.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / CYL#1 to CYL#4.
(e) Read the number of misfires on the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
HINT:
When a misfire is not reproduced, be sure to branch below based on the stored DTC.
Result:
High Misfire Rate Cylinder
Proceed to
1 or 2 cylinders
A
More than 3 cylinders
B
B
Go to step 15
A
5
CHECK SPARK PLUG AND SPARK OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
Base of the
Ground Electrode
(a)
(b)
(c)
Remove the ignition coil.
Remove the spark plug.
Check the spark plug type.
Recommended spark plug:
DENSO made
SK20R11
NGK made
IFR6A11
(d)
1.0 to 1.1 mm
A85380
Measure the spark plug electrode gap.
Standard: 1.0 to 1.1 mm (0.039 to 0.043 in.)
Maximum: 1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
NOTICE:
If adjusting the gap of a new spark plug, bend only the base
of the ground electrode. Do not touch the tip. Never attempt
to adjust the gap on a used plug.
(e) Check the electrode for carbon deposits.
(f)
Perform a spark test.
CAUTION:
Always disconnect each injector connector.
NOTICE:
Do not crank the engine for more than 2 seconds.
(1) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil and connect
the ignition coil connector.
(2) Disconnect the injector connector.
(3) Ground the spark plug.
(4) Check if spark occurs while the engine is being
cranked.
OK: Spark jumps across electrode gap.
OK
Go to step 8
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
342
05-153
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHANGE NORMAL SPARK PLUG AND CHECK SPARK OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(a) Change to a normal spark plug.
(b) Perform a spark test.
CAUTION:
Always disconnect each injector connector.
NOTICE:
Do not crank the engine for more than 2 seconds.
(1) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil and connect the ignition coil connector.
(2) Disconnect the injector connector.
(3) Ground the spark plug.
(4) Check if spark occurs while the engine is being cranked.
OK: Spark jumps across electrode gap.
OK
REPLACE SPARK PLUG
NG
7
CHECK WIRE HARNESS OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (IGNITION COIL - ECM)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
I2
I3
I4
I5
Ignition Coil
Check the wire harness between the ignition coil and
ECM.
(1) Disconnect the I2, I3, I4 and I5 ignition coil connectors.
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
E7
ECM
Tester Connection
I2-2
I3-2
I4-2
I5-2
I2-2
I3-2
I4-2
I5-2
(4)
IGF1
Y
A54393
A81699
or
or
or
or
-
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
-
Body
Body
Body
Body
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
ground
ground
ground
ground
10 kΩ or higher
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4 and I5 ignition coil connectors.
A85513
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
343
05-154
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
Wire Harness Side
I2
I3
I4
I5
Ignition Coil
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Check the wire harness between the ignition coil and
ECM.
(1) Disconnect the I2, I3, I4 and I5 ignition coil connectors.
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
E7
ECM
Y
A54393
A81699
IGT1
IGT2
IGT3
IGT4
OK
A85513
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I2-3 - E7-8 (IGT1)
I3-3 - E7-9 (IGT2)
I4-3 - E7-10 (IGT3)
I5-3 - E7-11 (IGT4)
Below 1 Ω
I2-3 or E7-8 (IGT1) - Body ground
I3-3 or E7-9 (IGT2) - Body ground
I4-3 or E7-10 (IGT3) - Body ground
I5-3 or E7-11 (IGT4) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE IGNITION COIL ASSY (THEN CONFIRM THAT THERE IS NO MISFIRE)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
344
05-155
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM TERMINAL OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (#1, #2, #3, #4 VOLTAGE)
#4 (+)
#3 (+)
#2 (+)
(a)
(b)
#1 (+)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
E01 (-)
E7-1
E7-2
E7-3
E7-4
E7
ECM
(#1)
(#2)
(#3)
(#4)
-
E7-7
E7-7
E7-7
E7-7
Specified Condition
(E01)
(E01)
(E01)
(E01)
9 to 14 V
A76903
HINT:
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope.
Check the waveform of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
#1 to #4 - E01
Engine idling
Connect waveform is as shown
Injector Signal Waveform
(Magnification)
20 V
/Division
20 V
/Division
GND
GND
100 msec./Division (Idling)
Injection duration
1 msec./Division (Idling)
A78423
OK
Go to step 11
NG
9
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR RESISTANCE OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(See page 11-7 )
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
(See page 11-10 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
345
05-156
DIAGNOSTICS
10
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (INJECTOR - ECM, INJECTOR
- IGNITION SWITCH)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
I8
I9
I10
I11
Injector
E7
ECM
#1 (+)
Check the wire harness between the injector and ECM.
(1) Disconnect the I8, I9, I10 and I11 injector connectors.
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I8-1 - E7-1 (#1)
I9-1 - E7-2 (#2)
I10-1 - E7-3 (#3)
I11-1 - E7-4 (#4)
Below 1 Ω
I8-1 or E7-1 (#1) - Body ground
I9-1 or E7-2 (#2) - Body ground
I10-1 or E7-3 (#3) - Body ground
I11-1 or E7-4 (#4) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
#2 (+)
#4(+)
A85366
A81699
#3 (+)
A85514
(b)
Instrument
Panel J/B
Assy
Check the IG2 fuse.
(1) Remove the IG2 fuse from the instrument panel J/B.
(2) Measure the resistance of the IG2 fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
IG2 Fuse
A90345
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
346
05-157
DIAGNOSTICS
(c)
Wire Harness Side
I8
I9
I10
I11
Injector
2
6
3
7
4
8
NG
IG2
A85366
A61075
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Check the wire harness between the injector and ignition
switch.
(1) Disconnect the I8, I9, I10 and I11 injector connectors.
(2) Disconnect the I15 ignition switch connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
I15
Ignition Switch
1
5
-
A90538
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I8-2 - I15-6 (IG2)
I9-2 - I15-6 (IG2)
I10-2 - I15-6 (IG2)
I11-2 - I15-6 (IG2)
Below 1 Ω
I8-2 or I15-6 (IG2) - Body ground
I9-2 or I15-6 (IG2) - Body ground
I10-2 or I15-6 (IG2) - Body ground
I11-2 or I15-6 (IG2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
11
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR INJECTION AND VOLUME OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(See page 11-7 )
Standard:
Injection Volume
76 to 91
cm3
Difference Between Each Injector
15 cm3 (0.9 cu in.) or less
(4.6 to 5.5 cu in.) / 15 seconds
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
OK
12
CHECK CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(See page 14-1 )
Standard:
Item
Specified Condition
Compression pressure
1.360 MPa (13.9 kgf/cm2, 198 psi)
Minimum pressure
0.98 MPa (10 kgf/cm2, 142 psi)
Difference between each cylinder
0.1 MPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 14 psi)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
347
05-158
DIAGNOSTICS
13
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK VALVE CLEARANCE OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (See page 14-6 )
Standard (cold):
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
0.19 to 0.29 mm (0.0075 to 0.0114 in.)
Exhaust
0.30 to 0.40 mm (0.0118 to 0.0157 in.)
NG
ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(See page 14-6 )
OK
14
SWITCH STEP BY NUMBER OF MISFIRE CYLINDER (REFER TO RESULTS OF
STEP 4)
HINT:
If the result of step 4 is ”1 or 2 cylinders”, proceed to A.
If the result of step 4 is ”more than 3 cylinders”, proceed to B.
B
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
A
15
(a)
CHECK VALVE TIMING (See page 14-68 )
Check for loose or jumped tooth of the timing chain.
OK: The matchmarks of the crankshaft pulley and camshaft pulley are alined.
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING (See page 14-68 )
OK
16
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE (See page 11-4 )
Standard:
Item
Specified Condition
Fuel pressure
304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 55 psi)
NG
CHECK
AND
REPLACE
FUEL
PUMP,
PRESSURE REGULATOR, FUEL PIPE LINE AND
FILTER
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
348
05-159
DIAGNOSTICS
17
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (INTAKE AIR
TEMPERATURE AND MASS AIR FLOW RATE)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the intake air temperature.
(1) On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR. Read the values.
Temperature: Equivalent to ambient temperature
Check the air flow rate.
(1) On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / MAF. Read the values.
Standard:
(d)
Condition
Air Flow Rate (gm/s)
Ignition switch ON (do not start engine)
0
Idling
0.5 to 5
Running without load (2,500 rpm)
3 to 10
Idling to quickly accelerating
Air flow rate fluctuates
NG
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
OK
18
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
Ohmmeter
Remove the ECT sensor.
Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
30
20
Resistance kΩ
10
5
Acceptable
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
-20
S01196
S01699
(-4)
0
20 40 60 80 100
(32) (68) (104) (140) (176) (212)
Temperature C (F)
A81700
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
20C (68F)
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ
1-2
80C (176F)
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ
NOTICE:
If checking the ECT sensor in water, be careful not to allow
water to contact the terminals. After the check, dry the sensor.
HINT:
Alternate procedure: Connect an ohmmeter to the installed
ECT sensor and read the resistance. Use an infrared thermometer to measure the engine temperature in the immediate vicinity of the sensor. Compare these values to the resistance/temperature graph. Change the engine temperature (warm up or
allow to cool down) and repeat the test.
NG
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
349
05-160
DIAGNOSTICS
19
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
SWITCH STEP BY NUMBER OF MISFIRE CYLINDER (REFER TO RESULTS OF
STEP 4)
HINT:
If the result of step 4 is ”1 or 2 cylinders”, proceed to A.
If the result of step 4 is ”more than 3 cylinders”, proceed to B.
B
AGAIN GO TO STEP 5
A
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS (See page 05-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
350
05-161
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ESX-04
DTC
P0325
KNOCK SENSOR 1 CIRCUIT (BANK 1 OR
SINGLE SENSOR)
DTC
P0327
KNOCK SENSOR 1 CIRCUIT LOW INPUT
(BANK 1 OR SINGLE SENSOR)
DTC
P0328
KNOCK SENSOR 1 CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
(BANK 1 OR SINGLE SENSOR)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A flat type knock sensor (non-resonant type) can detect vibrations in a wide band of frequency (about 6 kHz
to 15 kHz) and has the following features:
Knock sensors is fitted on the cylinder block to detect the engine knocking.
The sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when the cylinder block vibrates. If engine knocking occurs, the ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0325
Open or short in knock sensor circuit
(1 trip detection logic)
Open or short in knock sensor circuit
Knock sensor
ECM
P0327
Output voltage of the knock sensor is 0.5 V or less
(1 trip detection logic)
Short in knock sensor circuit
Knock sensor
ECM
P0328
Output voltage of the knock sensor is 4.5 V or more
(1 trip detection logic)
Open in knock sensor circuit
Knock sensor
ECM
HINT:
If the ECM detects the DTC P0325, it enters the fail-safe mode in which the corrective retarded angle value
is set to the maximum value.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The knock sensor, located on the cylinder block, detects spark knock. When a spark knock occurs, the sensor vibrates in a specific frequency range. When the ECM detects the voltage in this frequency range, it retards the ignition timing to suppress the spark knock.
The ECM also senses background engine noise with the knock sensor and uses this noise to check for faults
in the sensor. If the knock sensor signal level is too low for more than 10 seconds, and if the knock sensor
output voltage is out of normal range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the knock sensor and sets a DTC.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
351
05-162
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0325: Knock sensor range check (chattering)
P0327: Knock sensor range check (low voltage)
P0328: Knock sensor range check (high voltage)
Required sensors / components (Main)
Knock sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
MAF meter, CKP sensor, ECT sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
1 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Time after engine start
5 sec. or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Knock Sensor Range Check (Chattering) P0325:
Knock sensor voltage
Less than 0.5 V, or more than 4.5 V
Knock Sensor Range Check (Low voltage) P0327:
Knock sensor voltage
Less than 0.5 V
Knock Sensor Range Check (High voltage) P0328:
Knock sensor voltage
More than 4.5 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
5V
Shielded
1
B
E8
K1
Knock Sensor
2
1
KNK1
28
W
E8
BR
A
J7
J/C
BR
A
FKNK1
1
E9
E1
BR A
EE
A90298
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
352
05-163
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
READ OUTPUT DTC
Clear the DTC (see page 05-38 ).
Warm up the engine.
Run the engine at 3,000 rpm for 10 seconds or more.
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Turn ON the ignition switch. Push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
Read the DTC.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only P0325 is output again
A
P0325, P0327 and/or P0328 are output again
B
P0325, P0327 and/or P0328 are not output again
C
B
Go to step 3
C
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
A
2
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR
(a)
A85381
Check the knock sensor installation.
OK: Torque is 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
NG
TIGHTEN SENSOR
OK
REPLACE KNOCK SENSOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
353
05-164
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - KNOCK SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E8-1 (KNK1) - E8-28 (FKNK1)
20C (68F)
120 to 280 kΩ
KNK1
E8
ECM
FKNK1
A81695
NG
Go to step 5
OK
4
INSPECT ECM (KNK1 VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM terminals.
Voltage:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8-1 (KNK1) - E8-28 (FKNK1)
4.5 to 5.5 V
KNK1
E8
ECM
KNK1 Signal Waveform
FKNK1
A81695
1 V / DIV
GND
1 msec./ Division
HINT:
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope.
After warming up, run the engine at 4,000 rpm. Check the waveform between terminal KNK1 and FKNK1 of the ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8-1 (KNK1) - E8-28 (FKNK1)
Correct waveform is as shown
A85286
NG
REPLACE ECM (See Page 10-9 )
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NOTICE:
Fault may be intermittent. Check the harness and connectors carefully.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
354
05-165
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR
(a)
(b)
Ohmmeter
A65174
Remove the knock sensor.
Measure the resistance between the terminals.
OK: Resistance is 120 to 280 kΩ at 20C (68F)
NG
REPLACE KNOCK SENSOR
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
355
05-166
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ESY-05
DTC
P0335
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ”A”
CIRCUIT
DTC
P0339
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ”A”
CIRCUIT INTERMITTENT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft position sensor (CKP) system consists of a crankshaft position sensor plate and a pickup
coil.
The sensor plate has 34 teeth and is installed on the crankshaft. The pickup coil is made of an iron core and
magnet. The sensor plate rotates and as each tooth passes through the pickup coil, a pulse signal is generated. The pickup coil generates 34 signals for each engine revolution. Based on these signals, the ECM
calculates the crankshaft position and engine RPM. Using these calculations, the fuel injection time and ignition timing are controlled.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0335
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM during cranking
(2 trip detection logic)
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM with engine
speed 600 rpm or more (2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Signal plate (Crankshaft position sensor plate No. 1)
ECM
P0339
No crankshaft position sensor signal is input to ECM for 0.05
seconds or more, and conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met:
(a) Engine is at 1,000 rpm or more
(b) STA signal is OFF
(c) 3 seconds or more have elapsed after STA signal is
switched from ON to OFF
Same as DTC No. P0355
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is no signal from the crankshaft sensor even though the engine is cranking, the ECM interprets this
as a malfunction of the sensor.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0335: CKP sensor range check during cranking
P0335: CKP sensor range check during engine running
Required sensors/ components (Main)
CKP (Crankshaft position) sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
4.7 sec.: CKP Sensor Range Check during Cranking
0.5 sec.: CKP Sensor Range Check during Engine Running
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
CKP Sensor Range Check during Cranking P0335:
Starter
ON
Minimum battery voltage while starter is ON
Less than 11 V
CKP Sensor Range Check during Engine Running P0335:
Engine RPM
600 rpm or more
Starter
OFF
Time after starter turns from ON to OFF
3 sec. or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
356
05-167
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
CKP signal
No signal
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
CKP sensor voltage fluctuates when the crankshaft rotates 34 CKP signals per 1
revolution crankshaft
CKP signal
WIRING DIAGRAM
C1
Camshaft Position Sensor
ECM
Shielded
27
1
Y
2
L
E9
G2+
Signal Rotor on
Intake Camshaft
Shielded
25
1
R
2
G
Crankshaft Angle
Sensor Plate
C7
Crankshaft Position Sensor
E9
G
J7
J/C
A BR
A
A
24
E9
NE+
NE-
1
E9
E1
A BR
EE
A90299
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read values on the hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
(b) Start the engine and push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / ENGINE SPD.
The engine speed can be confirmed in DATA LIST using the hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool. If
there are no NE signals from the crankshaft position sensor despite the engine revolving, the engine
speed will be indicated as zero. If voltage output of the crankshaft position sensor is insufficient, the
engine speed will be indicated as lower than the actual rpm.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
357
05-168
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
A64984
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Cold
985 to 1,600 Ω
1-2
Hot
1,265 to 1,890 Ω
NOTICE:
In the above section, the terms ”cold” and ”hot” refer to the
temperature of the coils. ”Cold” means approximately
-10 C to 50C (14F to 122F). ”Hot” means approximately
50C to 100C (122F to 212F).
HINT:
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope.
During cranking or idling, check the waveform between the terminals of the ECM connector.
Standard:
E9
ECM
G2+ NE+
Disconnect the C7 sensor connector.
Measure the resistance between the terminals of the sensor.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-27 (G2+) - E9-24 (NE-)
E9-25 (NE+) - E9-24 (NE-)
Correct waveform is as shown
NE-
G2+ and NE+ Signal Waveforms
2 V/
Division
G2+
NE+
A81699
A76903
20 msec./Division (Idling)
A87927
NG
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(See page 18-6 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
358
05-169
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
C7
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Disconnect the C7 sensor connector.
Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
E9
ECM
NE+
Tester Connection
Specified
Condition
C7-1 - E9-25 (NE+)
C7-2 - E9-24 (NE-)
Below 1 Ω
C7-1 or E9-25 (NE+) - Body ground
C7-2 or E9-24 (NE-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NE-
Y
A54385
A81699
A85533
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
(a)
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR)
Check the crankshaft position sensor installation.
OK: Sensor is installed correctly.
NG
TIGHTEN SENSOR
OK
4
(a)
(b)
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PLATE NO.1 (TEETH OF SIGNAL
PLATE)
Remove the crankshaft position sensor plate No. 1 (see page 14-41 ).
Check the teeth of the signal plate.
OK: The pulley does not have any cracks or deformation.
NG
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
PLATE NO.1
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
359
05-170
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVD-05
DTC
P0340
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ”A”
CIRCUIT (BANK 1 OR SINGLE SENSOR)
DTC
P0341
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ”A”
CIRCUIT RANGE/PERFORMANCE (BANK 1
OR SINGLE SENSOR)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor, like the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor, consists of a magnet and
an iron core wrapped in copper wire. The camshaft has 3 teeth and the CMP sensor is installed so that it
can detect these teeth passing by. When the camshaft rotates and the teeth pass by the CMP sensor, the
magnet on the CMP sensor creates a magnetic field and voltage is generated in the copper wire. When the
crankshaft makes two rotation, voltage will be generated in the CMP sensor 3 times. The CKP sensor is
roughly the same. When the crankshaft makes one rotation, its 34 teeth pass by the CKP sensor and voltage
is generated 34 times. The camshaft rotates at half the speed of the crankshaft. Therefore, the CMP sensor
generates voltage 3 times in the time the crankshaft takes to make 2 rotations.
The ECM detects generation of these voltages to locate the camshaft position, which are used to indicate
the cylinder.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0340
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM during cranking
(2 trip detection logic)
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM with engine
speed 600 rpm or more (1 trip detection logic)
Open or short in camshaft position sensor circuit
Camshaft position sensor
Timing chain has a jumped tooth
ECM
P0341
While crankshaft rotates twice, camshaft position sensor signal
is input to ECM 12 times or more (1 trip detection logic)
Same as DTC No. P0340
HINT:
DTC P0340 indicates a malfunction related to the camshaft position sensor (+) circuit
(Wire harness (ECM - camshaft position sensor) and camshaft position sensor).
DTC P0341 indicates a malfunction related to the camshaft position sensor (-) circuit
(Wire harness (ECM - camshaft position sensor) and camshaft position sensor).
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is no signal from the camshaft position sensor even though the engine is cranking, or if the rotations
of the camshaft and the crankshaft are not synchronized, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction of the
sensor.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0340: CMP sensor range check
P0340: CMP/CKP misalignment
P0341: CMP sensor malfunction
Required sensors/ components (Main)
CMP (Camshaft position) sensor and VVT sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
5 sec.
MIL operation
2 driving cycles: CMP sensor range check
Immediate: CMP/CKP misalignment and CMP malfunction
CMP sensor malfunction
Sequence of operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
360
05-171
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
CMP Sensor Range Check P0340:
Starter
ON
Minimal battery voltage while starter is ON
Less than 11 V
CMP/CKP Misalignment and CMP Sensor Malfunction P0340:
Engine RPM
600 rpm or more
Starter
OFF
CMP Sensor Malfunction P0341:
Starter
After OFF to ON timing
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
CMP Sensor Range Check P0340:
CMP signal
No signal
CMP/CKP Misalignment P0340:
CMP and CKP phase
Misaligned
CMP Sensor Malfunction P0341:
CMP and CKP phase
Misaligned
CMP signal per 2 revolutions of crankshaft
12 CMP signals or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
CMP sensor signal
CMP sensor voltage fluctuates when the camshaft rotates
3 CMP signals per 2 revolutions of crankshaft
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 on page 05-166 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
361
05-172
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
A64984
E9
ECM
G2+
Disconnect the C1 sensor connector.
Measure the resistance between the terminals of the sensor.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Cold
835 to 1,400 Ω
1-2
Hot
1,060 to 1,645 Ω
NOTICE:
In the above section, the terms ”cold” and ”hot” refer to the
temperature of the coils. ”Cold” means approximately
-10 C to 50C (14F to 122F). ”Hot” means approximately
50C to 100C (122F to 212F).
HINT:
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope.
During cranking or idling, check the waveform between the terminals of the ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-27 (G2+) - E9-24 (NE-)
E9-25 (NE+) - E9-24 (NE-)
Correct waveform is as shown
NE+ NE-
G2+ and NE+ Signal Waveforms
2 V/
Division
G2+
NE+
A81699
A76903
20 msec./Division (Idling)
A87927
NG
REPLACE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(See page 18-5 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
362
05-173
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
C1
Camshaft Position Sensor
Disconnect the C1 sensor connector.
Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
E9
ECM
G2+
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C1-1 - E9-27 (G2+)
C1-2 - E9-24 (NE-)
Below 1 Ω
C1-1 or E9-27 (G2+) - Body ground
C1-2 or E9-24 (NE-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NE-
Y
A54385
A81699
A85533
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
(a)
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION (CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR)
Check the sensor installation.
OK: Sensor is installed correctly.
NG
TIGHTEN SENSOR
OK
4
(a)
(b)
INSPECT CAMSHAFT
Remove the camshafts (see page 14-79 ).
Check the camshaft lobes.
OK: The camshaft lobes do not have any cracks or deformation.
NG
REPLACE CAMSHAFT
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
363
05-174
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVG-05
DTC
P0351
IGNITION COIL ”A” PRIMARY/SECONDARY
CIRCUIT
DTC
P0352
IGNITION COIL ”B” PRIMARY/SECONDARY
CIRCUIT
DTC
P0353
IGNITION COIL ”C” PRIMARY/SECONDARY
CIRCUIT
DTC
P0354
IGNITION COIL ”D” PRIMARY/SECONDARY
CIRCUIT
HINT:
These DTCs indicate a malfunction related to primary circuit.
If DTC P0351 is displayed, check No. 1 ignition coil with igniter
If DTC P0352 is displayed, check No. 2 ignition coil with igniter
If DTC P0353 is displayed, check No. 3 ignition coil with igniter
If DTC P0354 is displayed, check No. 4 ignition coil with igniter
circuit.
circuit.
circuit.
circuit.
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A Direct Ignition System (DIS) is used on this vehicle.
The DIS is a 1-cylinder ignition system which ignites one cylinder with one ignition coil. In the 1-cylinder
ignition system, one spark plug is connected to the end of the secondary winding. High-voltage is generated
in the secondary winding and is applied directly to the spark plug. The spark of the spark plug passes from
the center electrode to the ground electrode.
The ECM determines the ignition timing and outputs the ignition signals (IGTs) for each cylinder. Using the
IGT, the ECM turns on and off the power transistor inside the igniter, which switches on and off current to
the primary coil. When current to the primary coil is cut off, high-voltage is generated in the secondary coil
and this voltage is applied to the spark plugs to create sparks inside the cylinders. As the ECM cuts the current to the primary coil, the igniter sends back the ignition confirmation signal (IGF) for each cylinder ignition
to the ECM.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
364
05-175
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
From Battery
Igniter
No. 1 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
IGT1
Crankshaft
Position
Sensor
No. 1 Spark Plug
IGF1
Ignition Coil
Camshaft
Position
Sensor
Other Sensors
ECT Sensor
MAF Meter
Throttle Position Sensor
Others
IGT2
No. 2 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
No. 2 Spark Plug
IGT3
No. 3 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
No. 3 Spark Plug
IGT4
No. 4 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
No. 4 Spark Plug
TAC
To Tachometer
A90874
DTC No.
P0351
P0352
P0353
P0354
DTC Detection Condition
No IGF signal to ECM while engine is running
(1 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF1 and IGT circuits (1 throught 4) from
ignition coil assy to ECM
Ignition coil assy (No. 1 throught No. 4)
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
365
05-176
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Ignition Coil with Igniter
IGT
ECM
Ignition Coil
Igniter
IGF
Ignition Signal
(IGT)
Ignition
Confirmation
Signal (IGF)
Normal
Malfunction
Circuit Open
Time
A82388
If the ECM does not receive the IGF after sending the IGT, it interprets this as a fault in the igniter and sets
a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0351: Igniter (Cylinder 1) malfunction
P0352: Igniter (Cylinder 2) malfunction
P0353: Igniter (Cylinder 3) malfunction
P0354: Igniter (Cylinder 4) malfunction
Required sensors/ components (Main)
Igniter
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.256 sec. + 4 sparks
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Either of the following condition is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Engine RPM
1,500 rpm or less
2. Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
IGF signal
ECM does not receive any IGF signal when ECM sends IGT signal to igniter
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
366
05-177
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
IGF signal
Igniter outputs IGF signal when it receives IGT signal from ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
2
BR
I2
Ignition Coil with
Igniter No. 1
3
4
BR
EB1
R
1
5V
R-W
2 W-R
4
S28
1 IC3
I3
Ignition Coil with
W-R
Igniter No. 2
3
1
R W-B
GR
O
6 1F
R
4
W-B
1 1C
R
IG2
1 1G
R
Instrument
Panel J/B
Assy
B
4
W-B
AM2
1
IGF1
Short
Connector
P
9
E7
IGT2
Y-B
10
E7 IGT3
2
W-R
I5
Ignition Coil with
W-R
Igniter No. 4
3
1
W-B
IG2
6
7
IGT1
R
I15
Ignition Switch
Y
E7
4
24
W-R
E7
S29
2
W-R
I4
Ignition Coil with
W-R
Igniter No. 3
1
3
W-B
4 1C
8
R
4
W-B
IC1
L-Y
11
E7
IGT4
2
L-Y
10
AM2
1
F7
FL Block Assy
R
1
BR
W-B
W
FL
Main
Battery
E9
E1
A
N1
Noise Filter
J7
J/C
1
BR
EF
A
EE
A90300
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
367
05-178
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK SPARK PLUG AND SPARK OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (See page 18-3 )
OK: Spark occurs.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (IGNITION COIL ASSY - ECM (IGF TERMINAL))
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
I2
I3
I4
I5
Ignition Coil
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4 and I5 ignition coil connectors.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
I2-2
I3-2
I4-2
I5-2
E7
ECM
I2-2
I3-2
I4-2
I5-2
Y
A54393
A81699
-
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
Specified Condition
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
or E7-24 (IGF1) or E7-24 (IGF1) or E7-24 (IGF1) or E7-24 (IGF1) -
Below 1 Ω
Body ground
Body ground
Body ground
Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF1
A85848
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
368
05-179
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK ECM (IGF1 VOLTAGE)
IGF1 (+)
E7
ECM
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
(a)
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4 and I5 ignition coil connectors.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-24 (IGF1) - E9-1 (E1)
4.5 to 5.5 V
A76903
HINT:
Reference: Inspection using the oscilloscope.
During cranking or idling, check the waveform of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
IGF1 (+)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-24 (IGF1) - E9-1 (E1)
Correct waveform is as shown
E1 (-)
E7
ECM
E9
ECM
IGT and IGF Signal Waveform
2 V/
Division
CH1
(IGT1 to 4)
GND
CH2
(IGF1)
20 msec./Division
GND
A76903
A35500
A87928
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OK
REPLACE IGNITION COIL ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
369
05-180
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
I2
I3
I4
I5
Ignition Coil
IGT4 (+)
Y
A54393
A81699
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (IGNITION COIL ASSY - ECM (IGT TERMINAL))
Wire Harness Side
E7
ECM
-
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4 and I5 ignition coil connectors.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
IGT3 (+)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I2-3 - E7-8 (IGT1)
I3-3 - E7-9 (IGT2)
I4-3 - E7-10 (IGT3)
I5-3 - E7-11 (IGT4)
Below 1 Ω
I2-3 or E7-8 (IGT1) - Body ground
I3-3 or E7-9 (IGT2) - Body ground
I4-3 or E7-10 (IGT3) - Body ground
I5-3 or E7-11 (IGT4) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGT1 (+)
IGT2 (+)
A85848
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
370
05-181
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK ECM
(a)
IGT3 (+)
IGT4 (+)
IGT2 (+)
IGT1 (+)
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors when the engine is cranked.
Standard:
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
E7
ECM
IGT2 (+)
IGT1 (+)
(b)
(c)
E9
ECM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-8 (IGT1) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-9 (IGT2) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-10 (IGT3) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-1 1 (IGT4) - E9-1 (E1)
4.5 V or more
A76903
IGT3 (+)
IGT4 (+) IGT2 (+) IGT1 (+)
HINT:
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope.
During cranking or idling, check the waveform of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
E1 (-)
E7
ECM
More than 0.1 V or less than 4.5 V
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4 and I5 ignition coil connectors.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors when the engine is cranked.
Standard:
E1 (-)
E7
ECM
Specified Condition
A76903
IGT3 (+)
IGT4 (+)
Tester Connection
E7-8 (IGT1) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-9 (IGT2) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-10 (IGT3) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-1 1 (IGT4) - E9-1 (E1)
E9
ECM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-8 (IGT1) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-9 (IGT2) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-10 (IGT3) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-1 1 (IGT4) - E9-1 (E1)
Correct waveform is as shown
IGT and IGF Signal Waveform
2 V/
Division
CH1
(IGT1 to 4)
GND
CH2
(IGF1)
20 msec./Division
A76903
A35500
GND
A87928
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
371
05-182
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK IGNITION COIL ASSY (POWER SOURCE)
Wire Harness Side
I2
I3
I4
I5
Ignition Coil
(a)
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4 and I5 ignition coil connectors.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector
and body ground.
Standard:
Tester Connection
I2-1
I3-1
I4-1
I5-1
A54393
OK
-
Body
Body
Body
Body
Specified Condition
ground
ground
ground
ground
9 to 14 V
REPLACE IGNITION COIL ASSY
NG
7
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (IGNITION COIL ASSY - IGNITION SWITCH)
(a)
Check the IG2 fuse.
(1) Remove the IG2 fuse from the instrument panel J/B
Assy.
(2) Measure the resistance of the IG2 fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4 and I5 ignition coil connectors.
Disconnect the I15 ignition switch connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Instrument
Panel J/B
Assy
IG2 fuse
A90345
Wire Harness Side
I2
I3
I4
I5
Ignition Coil
Tester Connection
I15
Ignition Switch
1
5
Y
A54393
A61075
2
6
3
7
IG2
I2-1
I3-1
I4-1
I5-1
or
or
or
or
I2-1
I3-1
I4-1
I5-1
-
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
(IG2)
(IG2)
(IG2)
(IG2)
-
Specified Condition
(IG2)
(IG2)
(IG2)
(IG2)
Body
Body
Body
Body
Below 1 Ω
ground
ground
ground
ground
10 kΩ or higher
4
8
A85536
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
372
05-183
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
REPLACE IGNITION COIL ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
373
05-184
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0420
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EW2-05
CATALYST SYSTEM EFFICIENCY BELOW
THRESHOLD (BANK 1)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses sensors mounted before and after the three-way catalyst (TWC) to monitor its efficiency. The
first sensor, an Air Fuel ratio (A/F) sensor, sends pre-catalyst A/F ratio information to the ECM. The second
sensor, a heated oxygen sensor (O2S), sends post-catalyst information to the ECM. The ECM compares
these two signals to judge the efficiency of the catalyst and the catalyst’s ability to store oxygen. During normal operation, the TWC stores and releases oxygen as needed. The capacity to store oxygen results in a
low variation in the post-TWC exhaust stream as shown below.
If the catalyst is functioning normally, the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor slowly switches between
RICH and LEAN. If the catalyst is deteriorated, the waveform will alternate frequently between RICH and
LEAN. As the catalyst efficiency degrades, its ability to store oxygen is reduced and the catalyst output becomes more variable. When running the monitor, the ECM compares sensor 1 signals (A/F sensor) over a
specific amount of time to determine catalyst efficiency. The ECM begins by calculating the signal length for
both sensors (for the rear oxygen sensor, the ECM uses the output voltage signal length). If the oxygen sensor output voltage signal length is greater than the threshold (threshold is calculated based on the A/F sensor
signal length), the ECM concludes that the catalyst is malfunctioning. The ECM will turn on the MIL and a
DTC will be set.
Normal Catalyst
Waveform of Heated Oxygen Sensor
After Catalyst
Waveform of A/F Sensor
Before Catalyst
3.5 V
1.0 V
3.0 V
0.5 V
0V
10 seconds
Waveform of A/F Sensor
Before Catalyst
Waveform of Heated Oxygen Sensor
After Catalyst
Deteriorated Catalyst
3.5 V
1.0 V
3.0 V
0.5 V
0V
10 seconds
A85838
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
374
05-185
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Heated Oxygen Sensor Signal Length
Signal Length
Sensor
Output
Voltage
Time
A82718
DTC No.
P0420
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
After engine and catalyst are warmed up, and while vehicle is
driven within set vehicle and engine speed, waveform of
heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) alternates frequently
between RICH and LEAN (2 trip detection logic)
Gas leakage in exhaust system
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Three-way catalytic converter (Exhaust manifold)
HINT:
Sensor 1 is the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
Sensor 2 is the sensor farthest away from the engine assembly.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0420: Catalyst deterioration
Required sensors / components (Main)
Catalyst
Required sensors / components (Related)
A/F sensor, Heated oxygen sensor (HO2S), IAT sensor, MAF meter, CKP sensor,
ECT sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
150 sec. (30 sec. x 5)
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
Accumulated time that the following conditions are met:
30 sec.
Battery voltage
11 V or more
IAT
-10 C (14F) or more
Idle status
OFF
MAF
8 to 35 g/sec.
Engine RPM
Less than 4,500 rpm
ECT
75C (167F) or more
Rich experience after fuel cut
Yes
Fuel system status
Closed Loop
A/F sensor
Activated
Rear HO2S
Activated
Estimated catalyst temperature
Both of the following conditions 1 and 2 are met:
1. Upstream catalyst temperature
500 to 900C (932 to 1,652F)
2. Downstream catalyst temperature
350 to 900C (662 to 1,652F)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
375
05-186
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Rear HO2S locus length
13 V or more (Varies with A/F sensor locus length)
Frequency of the monitor
4 times
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-24 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-26 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $01: Catalyst - Sensor 1 A/F sensor, Sensor 2 HO2S
TLT
0
CID
$01
Unit Conversion
Description of Test Data
Description of Test Limit
Catalyst deterioration level:
Determined by waveforms of A/F sensor
and HO2S
Multiply by 0.0078
(no dimension)
Malfunction criteria for catalyst deterioration
CONDITIONING A/F SENSOR AND HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR FOR TESTING
Engine Speed
(c)
(d)
3,000 rpm
2,000 rpm
Idling
(a)
IG SW OFF
(b)
Time
Warmed up
3 minutes or so
2 seconds 2 seconds
Check
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
A90911
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessories switched OFF until the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is stable.
Run the engine at 2,500 to 3,000 rpm for about 3 minutes.
When alternating the engine between 3,000 rpm and 2,000 rpm for 2 seconds respectively, check the
waveform of the oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
376
05-187
DIAGNOSTICS
1
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0420)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
Only P0420 is output
A
P0420 and other DTCs are output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0420 are output, perform the troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-48 )
A
2
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
LEAKAGE POINT
EXHAUST
GAS
OK
3
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (BANK 1 SENSOR 1) (See page 12-6 )
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
4
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (See page 05-1 18)
OK: During air-fuel ratio feedback, the O2S’s output alternates between rich and lean.
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OK
REPLACE EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
377
05-188
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
The following procedure enables a technician to identify a trouble area if there is a malfunction in front
A/F sensor or rear heated oxygen sensors other than the catalyst converter, or the malfunction that
indicates the actual air-fuel ratio extremely RICH or LEAN.
It is possible the malfunctioning area can be found using the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation. The
A/F CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential trouble
areas are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume 12.5 % or increases the injection volume 25 %.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Warm up the engine by running the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(5) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine idle (press the right or left button).
Result:
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume
+25 % → rich output: More than 0.5 V
-12.5 % → lean output: Less than 0.4 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
378
05-189
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Output voltage of A/F sensor
(sensor 1)
Output voltage of heated oxygen
sensor (sensor 2)
Injection volume
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 1 Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
OK
More than 0.55 V
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 2 Output voltage
A/F sensor
(A/F sensor, heater, A/F sensor circuit)
Output voltage
NG
Injection volume
More than 0.55 V
OK
Less than 0.4V
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 3 Output voltage
Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
OK
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
NG
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 4 Output voltage
Almost
No reaction
OK
Less than 0.4V
+25 %
Less than 3.0V
Output voltage
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Main suspect
trouble area
Output voltage
NG
Almost
No reaction
NG
Heated oxygen sensor
(heated oxygen sensor,
heater, heated oxygen sensor
circuit)
Extremely rich or lean actual
air-fuel ratio
(Injector, fuel pressure, gas
leakage in exhaust system,
etc.)
The following of A/F CONTROL procedure enables a technician to check and graph the voltage outputs of
both the heated oxygen sensors.
For displaying the graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2” by pressing ”YES” and push ”ENTER”. Then press ”F4”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
379
05-190
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
05PGO-01
DTC
P043E
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
REFERENCE ORIFICE CLOG UP
DTC
P043F
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
REFERENCE ORIFICE HIGH FLOW
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to EVAP Inspection Procedure (see page 05-317).
DTCs
P043E
P043F
Monitoring Item
0.02 inch orifice clogged
(built-in pump module)
0.02 inch orifice high-flow
(built-in pump module)
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
To determine leak criterion (Reference
pressure), vacuum pump creates negative
pressure in canister pump module through
0.02 inch orifice and pressure is measured.
Pump module
If one of following conditions is met, ECM
Connector / wire harness
sets pump module related DTCs: P043E,
P043E
(Pump module - ECM)
P043F, P2401, P2402 and P2419:
ECM
Reference pressure is -1 kPa or higher
Reference pressure is -4.85 kPa or lower
Reference pressure is not saturated within
60 seconds
Detection
Timing
Detection
Period
Ignition
OFF
2 trips
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to EVAP Inspection Procedure (see page 05-317).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to EVAP Inspection Procedure (see page 05-317).
Author:
Date:
380
05-191
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the electric vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions
based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35C (95F) after 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned
off, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35C (95F) 7 hours after the ignition switch
is turned off, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
-
Operations
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer, 5 hours (7 or 9.5 hours) after ignition switch turned to OFF.
A
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and EVAP system pressure measured by ECM in order to
register atmospheric pressure.
If EVAP pressure is not between 70 kPa and 110 kPa (525 mmHg and 825 mmHg), ECM
cancels EVAP system monitor.
-
10 seconds
B
First 0.02 inch leak
pressure measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through 0.02 inch orifice and then ECM checks if vacuum pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
C
EVAP system pressure measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system, and EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down the measured value as it will be used in the leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not stabilize within 15 minutes, ECM cancels EVAP system monitor.
15 minutes*
D
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then EVAP system pressure measured by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak
pressure measurement
Leak check is performed after second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard is measured.
If stabilized system pressure higher than second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, ECM
determines that EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured and then monitoring result recorded by ECM.
-
* If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement Operation B, E: 0.02 Inch Leak Pressure Measurement
Canister
Fuel Tank
OFF
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
OFF (vent)
Purge VSV: OFF
0.02 Inch Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Air Filter
ON
Pump Module
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
Vacuum Pump: OFF
OFF
Operation D: Purge VSV monitor
ON
ON (closed)
ON (closed)
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
Negative
Pressure
ON
A96746
Author:
Date:
381
05-192
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
In sequence B and E, to determine the leak criterion, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure in the
canister pump module through the 0.02 inch orifice. If the pressure is out of specified range or is not saturated, the ECM illuminates the MIL and sets DTCs P043E, P043F, P2401, P2402 and P2419 (2-trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure during EVAP Monitor
Purge VSV
OFF
OFF
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
Vent Valve
OFF
OFF
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
ON
Vacuum Pump
Malfunction
Malfunction
EVAP Pressure
-1 kPa
Specified
OK
OK
Malfunction
Malfunction
Range
-4.85 kPa
Sequence
Time
A
B
10
sec
60
sec
C
D
E
Within 15 minutes
10
sec
60
sec
A85217
Author:
Date:
382
05-193
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
OBD II MONITOR SPECIFICATIONS
Monitor Strategy
Required Sensors/Components
Pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 15 minutes (varies with amount of fuel in tank)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
Typical Enabling Conditions
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16.
EVAP key-off monitor runs when all of the following conditions met:
-
Atmospheric pressure
525 to 825 mmHg (70 to 110 kPa)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
Below 4 km/h (2.5 mph)
Ignition switch
OFF
Engine condition
Not running
Time after engine stopped
5 hours
FTP sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
Purge VSV
Not operated by scan tool
Vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
Leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before IG switch
OFF:
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle is driven
5 min. or more
2. Purge flow
Executed
ECT
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
IAT
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
Example of re-start time
First time
7 hours
Second time
9 hours and 30 min.
Key-of f monitor sequence: 1 to 8
1. Atmospheric pressure
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
Atmospheric pressure change for 10 sec.
Within 2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) for 1 sec.
2. First reference pressure
Next sequence is run if all of following conditions met
Condition 1, 2 and 3
1. FTP when 4 sec. after reference pressure measurement
-7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa) or less
2. Reference pressure
-36.47 to -7.93 mmHg (-4.85 to -1.057 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
Saturated
3. Vent valve stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP change for 10 sec. after vent valve ON (closed)
2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) or more
4. Vacuum introduction and leak
Next sequence is run if both of following conditions met
Condition 1 and 2
1. Vacuum introduction time
Within 15 min.
2. FTP
FTP was saturated
5. Purge VSV stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP change for 10 sec. after purge VSV ON (open)
2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) or more
Author:
Date:
383
05-194
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
6. Second reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if all of following conditions met
Condition 1, 2, 3 and 4
1. FTP when 4 sec. after reference pressure measurement
-7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa) or less
2. Reference pressure
-36.47 to -7.93 mmHg (-4.85 to -1.057 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
Saturated
4. Reference pressure difference between first and second
Less than 5.25 mmHg (0.7 kPa)
7. Leak check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP when vacuum introduction was complete
Lower than second reference pressure
8. Atmospheric pressure
Monitor is complete if following
-
Atmospheric pressure difference between sequence 1 and 8
Within 2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa)
Typical Malfunction Thresholds
Following values are when atmosperic pressure is 760
mmHg (100 kPa)
-
One of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5
1. FTP when 4 seconds after reference pressure measurement began
More than -7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa)
2. Reference pressure
Less than -36.4 mmHg (-4.85 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
-7.9 mmHg (-1.057 kPa) or more
4. Reference pressure
Not saturated
5. Reference pressure difference between first and second
5.3 mmHg (0.7 kPa) or more
MONITOR RESULT (MODE 06)
Refer to page 05-317 for detailed information on Monitor Result.
Author:
Date:
384
05-195
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
-MEMO-
Author:
Date:
385
05-196
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0441
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05HB6-02
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL
SYSTEM INCORRECT PURGE FLOW
DTC SUMMARY
DTCs
P0441
P0441
P0441
Monitoring Items
Malfunction Detection Conditions
Detection
Timings
Trouble Areas
Detection
Logic
Purge VSV (Vacuum
Switching Valve) stuck
open
Vacuum pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in EVAP system and EVAP system pressure measured. 0.02 inch leak
pressure standard is measured at the start
and at the end of the leak check.
If stabilized pressure higher than [second
0.02 inch leak pressure standard x 0.2],
ECM determines that purge VSV stuck
open
Purge VSV
Connector/wire harness
(Purge VSV - ECM)
ECM
Pump module
Leakage from EVAP system
While ignition
Switch OFF
2 trip
Purge VSV stuck closed
After EVAP leak check performed, purge
VSV turned ON (open), and atmospheric
air introduced into EVAP system. 0.02 inch
leak pressure standard is measured at the
start and at the end of the leak check.
If pressure does not return to near atmospheric pressure, ECM determines that
purge valve stuck closed
Purge VSV
Connector/wire harness
(Purge VSV - ECM)
ECM
Pump module
Leakage from EVAP system
While ignition
Switch OFF
2 trip
Purge flow
While engine running, following conditions
successively met:
Negative pressure not created in EVAP
system when purge VSV turned ON
(open)
EVAP system pressure change less than
0.5 kPa (3.75 mmHg) when vent valve
turned ON (closed)
Atmospheric pressure change before and
after purge flow monitor less than 0.1 kPa
(0.75 mmHg)
Purge VSV
Connector/wire harness
(Purge VSV - ECM)
Leakage from EVAP line
(Purge VSV - Intake manifold)
ECM
While engine
running
2 trip
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) Inspection Procedure (see page
05-317 ).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP Inspection Procedure (see page 05-317 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
386
05-197
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The two monitors, Key-Off and Purge Flow, are used to detect malfunctions relating to DTC P0441. The
Key-Of f monitor is initiated by the ECM internal timer, known as the soak timer, 5 hours* after the ignition
switch is turned to OFF. The purge flow monitor runs while the engine is running.
1.
KEY-OFF MONITOR
5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the electric vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions
based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35C (95F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned off,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35C (95F) 7 hours after the ignition switch is
turned off, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
-
Operations
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer, 5 hours (7 or 9.5 hours) after ignition switch turned to OFF.
A
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and EVAP system pressure measured by ECM in order to
register atmospheric pressure.
If EVAP pressure is not between 70 kPa and 110 kPa (525 mmHg and 825 mmHg), ECM
cancels EVAP system monitor.
-
10 seconds
B
First 0.02 inch leak
pressure measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through 0.02 inch orifice and then ECM checks if vacuum pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
C
EVAP system pressure measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system, and EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down the measured value as it will be used in the leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not stabilize within 15 minutes, ECM cancels EVAP system monitor.
15 minutes*
D
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then EVAP system pressure measured by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak
pressure measurement
Leak check is performed after second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard is measured.
If stabilized system pressure higher than second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, ECM
determines that EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured and then monitoring result recorded by ECM.
-
* If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
387
05-198
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement Operation B, E: 0.02 Inch Leak Pressure Measurement
Canister
Fuel Tank
OFF
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
OFF (vent)
Purge VSV: OFF
0.02 Inch Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Air Filter
ON
Pump Module
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
Vacuum Pump: OFF
OFF
Operation D: Purge VSV monitor
ON
ON (closed)
ON (closed)
Atmospheric
Pressure
Negative
Pressure
ON
ON
A96746
(a) Purge VSV stuck open
In operation C, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission)
system. The EVAP system pressure is then measured by the ECM using the pressure sensor. If the stabilized
system pressure is higher than [second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard x 0.2], the ECM interprets this as
the purge VSV (Vacuum Switching Valve) being stuck open. The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC
(2 trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when Purge VSV Stuck Open:
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ON
Vent Valve
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
Malfunction
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
Second 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard x 0.2
OK
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Sequence
Time
A
B
10
sec
60
sec
C
D
E
Within 15 minutes
10
sec
60
sec
G36775
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
388
05-199
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
(b) Purge VSV stuck closed
In operation D, the pressure sensor measures the EVAP system pressure. The pressure measurement for
purge VSV monitor is begun when the purge VSV is turned ON (open) after the EVAP leak check. When
the measured pressure indicates an increase of 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more, the purge VSV is functioning
normally. If the pressure does not increase, the ECM interprets this as the purge VSV being stuck closed.
The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when Purge VSV Stuck Closed:
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ON
Vent Valve
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
Vacuum Pump
EVAP Pressure
OK
Positive
Negative
Malfunction
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Sequence
Time
A
B
10
sec
60
sec
C
D
E
Within 15 minutes
10
60
sec
G36776
EVAP Pressure
During Purge Flow Monitor:
Purge
VSV
Open
Vent
Valve
ON (closed)
Malfunction
EVAP
Pressure
0.1 kPa
OK
OK
1st
Monitor
0.5 kPa
2nd
Monitor
A71563
2.
PURGE FLOW MONITOR
The purge flow monitor consists of the two step monitors. The
1st monitor is conducted every time and the 2nd monitor is activated if necessary.
The 1st monitor
While the engine is running and the purge VSV
(Vacuum Switching Valve) is ON (open), the ECM
monitors the purge flow by measuring the EVAP
pressure change. If negative pressure is not
created, the ECM begins the 2nd monitor.
The 2nd monitor
The vent valve is turned ON (closed) and the EVAP
pressure is then measured. If the variation in the
pressure is less than 0.5 kPa (3.75 mmHg), the
ECM interprets this as the purge VSV being stuck
closed, and illuminates the MIL and sets DTC
P0441 (2 trip detection logic).
Atmospheric pressure check:
In order to ensure reliable malfunction detection, the variation
between the atmospheric pressures, before and after conduction of the purge flow monitor, is measured by the ECM.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
389
05-200
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
OBD II MONITOR SPECIFICATIONS (Key-off Monitor)
Monitor Strategy
Required Sensors/Components
Purge VSV and pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 15 minutes (varies with fuel in tank)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
Typical Enabling Conditions
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
EVAP key-off monitor runs when all of the following conditions met
-
Atmospheric pressure
525 to 825 mmHg (70 to 110 kPa)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
Below 4 km/h (2.5 mph)
Ignition switch
OFF
Engine condition
Not running
Time after engine stopped
5 hours
FTP sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
Purge VSV
Not operated by scan tool
Vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
Leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before IG switch
OFF:
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle is driven
5 min. or more
2. Purge flow
Executed
ECT
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
IAT
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
Example of re-start time
First time
7 hours
Second time
9 hours and 30 min.
Key-of f monitor sequence: 1 to 8
1. Atmospheric pressure
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
Atmospheric pressure change for 10 sec.
Within 2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) for 1 sec.
2. First reference pressure
Next sequence is run if all of following conditions met
Condition 1, 2 and 3
1. FTP when 4 sec. after reference pressure measurement
-7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa) or less
2. Reference pressure
-36.47 to -7.93 mmHg (-4.85 to -1.057 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
Saturated
3. Vent valve stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP change for 10 sec. after vent valve ON (closed)
2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) or more
4. Vacuum introduction and leak
Next sequence is run if both of following conditions met
Condition 1 and 2
1. Vacuum introduction time
Within 15 min.
2. FTP
FTP was saturated
5. Purge VSV stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP change for 10 sec. after purge VSV ON (open)
2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
390
05-201
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
6. Second reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if all of following conditions met
Condition 1, 2, 3 and 4
1. FTP when 4 sec. after reference pressure measurement
-7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa) or less
2. Reference pressure
-36.47 to -7.93 mmHg (-4.85 to -1.057 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
Saturated
4. Reference pressure difference between first and second
Less than 5.25 mmHg (0.7 kPa)
7. Leak check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP when vacuum introduction was complete
Lower than second reference pressure
8. Atmospheric pressure
Monitor is complete if following
-
Atmospheric pressure difference between sequence 1 and 8
Within 2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa)
Typical Malfunction Thresholds
Purge VSV stuck open
FTP when vacuum introduction was complete
Higher than reference pressure x 0.2
Purge VSV stuck closed
FTP change for 10 seconds after purge VSV ON (open)
Less than 2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa)
OBD II MONITOR SPECIFICATIONS (Purge Flow Monitor)
Monitor Strategy
Required Sensors/Components
Purge VSV and pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 30 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence Operation
None
Typical Enabling Conditions
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Engine
Running
ECT
4.4C (40F) or more
IAT
4.4C (40F) or more
FTP sensor malfunction
Not detected
Purge VSV
Not operated by scan tool
EVAP system check
Not operated by scan tool
Battery voltage
10 V or more
Purge duty cycle
8 % or more
Typical Malfunction Thresholds
Both of the following conditions are met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. FTP change when purge operation is started
Less than 0.75 mmHg (0.1 kPa)
2. FTP change during purge operation when vent valve is
closed
Less than 3.75 mmHg (0.5 kPa)
MONITOR RESULT (MODE 06)
Refer to page 05-317 for detailed information on Monitor Result.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
391
05-202
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05IR9-02
DTC
P0450
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM PRESSURE SENSOR/SWITCH
DTC
P0451
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM PRESSURE SENSOR RANGE/PERFORMANCE
DTC
P0452
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM PRESSURE SENSOR/SWITCH LOW INPUT
DTC
P0453
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM PRESSURE SENSOR/SWITCH HIGH INPUT
DTC SUMMARY
Detection
Logic
Monitoring Items
Malfunction Detection Conditions
P0450
Pressure sensor voltage abnormal fluctuation
Sensor output voltage rapidly fluctuates
beyond upper and lower malfunction
thresholds for 0.5 seconds.
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness
(Pump module - ECM)
ECM
EVAP monitoring (ignition
OFF)
Ignition ON
1 trip
Pressure sensor noising
Sensor output voltage fluctuates frequently in certain time period.
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness
(Pump module - ECM)
ECM
EVAP monitoring (ignition
OFF)
Engine running
2 trip
Pressure sensor stuck
Sensor output voltage does vary in certain time period.
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness
(Pump module - ECM)
ECM
EVAP monitoring (ignition
OFF)
2 trip
P0452
Pressure sensor voltage low
Sensor output voltage is less than 0.45
V for 0.5 seconds.
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness
(Pump module - ECM)
ECM
Ignition ON
EVAP monitoring (ignition
OFF)
1 trip
P0453
Sensor output voltage is more than 4.9
Pressure sensor voltage high
V for 0.5 seconds.
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness
(Pump module - ECM)
ECM
Ignition ON
EVAP monitoring (ignition
OFF)
1 trip
P0451
P0451
Trouble Areas
Detection Timings
DTC
HINT:
The pressure sensor is built into the pump module.
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) Inspection Procedure (see page
05-317 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
392
05-203
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
(a)
Pressure Sensor Specification:
Malfunction Area
Output Voltage
4.900 V
4.150 V
Usable Range
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
0.450 V
60
kPa
110
kPa
(b)
Pressure
HINT:
Standard atmospheric pressure is 101.3 kPa
A71562
(c)
(d)
DTC P0450: Pressure sensor voltage abnormal fluctuation.
If the pressure sensor voltage output rapidly fluctuates
between less than 0.45 V and more than 4.9 V, the ECM
interprets this as an open or short circuit malfunction in
the pressure sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP
(Evaporative Emission) system monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
DTC P0451: Pressure sensor noising or stuck
If the pressure sensor voltage output fluctuates rapidly for
10 seconds, the ECM stops the EVAP system monitor.
The ECM interprets this as noise from the pressure sensor, and stops the EVAP system monitor. The ECM then
illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
Alternatively, if the sensor voltage output does not
change for 10 seconds, the ECM interprets this as the
sensor being stuck, and stops the monitor. The ECM then
illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
(Both the malfunctions are detected by 2 trip detection
logic)
DTC P0452: Pressure sensor voltage low
If the pressure sensor voltage output is below 0.45 V, the
ECM interprets this as an open or short circuit malfunction
in the pressure sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP
system monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and
sets the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
DTC P0453: Pressure sensor voltage high
If the pressure sensor voltage output is 4.9 V or more, the
ECM interprets this as an open or short circuit malfunction
in the pressure sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP
system monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and
sets the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
393
05-204
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
OBD II MONITOR SPECIFICATIONS
Monitor Strategy
Required Sensors/Components
Pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle: P0451 FTP sensor output ”Stuck”
Continuous: P0451 FTP sensor ”Noise”, P0450, P0452 and P0453
Duration
0.5 sec.: P0450, P0452 and P0453
10 sec.: P0451
MIL Operation
Immediate: P0450, P0452 and P0453
2 driving cycles: P0451
Sequence of Operation
None
Typical Enabling Conditions
P0451: FTP sensor ”Noise”
Monitor runs whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Atmospheric pressure (absolute pressure)
70 kPa (525 mmHg) or more, less than 110 kPa (825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Intake air temperature
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
FTP sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
Either of following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Engine
Running
2. Time after engine stopped
5 hours
Example of re-start time
First time
7 hours
Second time
9 hours and 30 min.
P0451: FTP sensor output ”Stuck”
Monitor runs whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Intake air temperature
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
FTP sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
Atmospheric pressure (absolute pressure)
Less than 70 kPa (525 mmHg), or 110 kPa (825 mmHg) or more
Time after engine stopped
5 hours
Example of re-start time
First time
7 hours
Second time
9 hours and 30 min.
P0450, P0452 and P0453:
Monitor runs whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Ignition switch
ON
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Starter
OFF
Typical Malfunction Thresholds
P0450: Pressure sensor chattering
Pressure sensor voltage
Less than 0.45 V, or more than 4.9 V
P0451: FTP sensor ”Noise”
Frequency that FTP change is 2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) or
more
10 times or more in 10 sec.
P0451: FTP sensor output ”Stuck”
FTP change for 10 sec. during EVAP monitor (Reference
pressure)
Less than 4.88 mmHg (0.65 kPa)
P0452: Pressure sensor low voltage
Pressure sensor voltage
Less than 0.45 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
394
05-205
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
P0453: Pressure sensor high voltage
Pressure sensor voltage
More than 4.9 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
C17
Pump Module
Pressure Sensor
ECM
16
BJ1
4
L
12
BJ1
3
Y
BR
Vacuum Pump
1
W
8
B
W-B
Y
17
BJ1 BR
13
BJ1
W
14
BJ1
R
18
BJ1
V
2
6
L
Vent Valve
9
R
7
IO1
P
15
IO1
BR
16
IO1
B-R
SB
GR
5
IM1
1
2I
W
FL MAIN
A
Battery
BR
B-R
28
E2
E7
4
MPMP
E5
27
VPMP
E5
Y-G
1
G
34
PRG
E7
B
8
MREL
E5
2
V4
Purge VSV
B-R
2
BF
5
S29
LG
14
IM1
5V
Engine Room J/B
EFI No. 2
W-B
J19
J/C
5
S28
BR
VC
21
PPMP
E5
L
12
IM1
4
IO1
5
IO1
18
E7
Y
3
IO1
1
EB1
BJ1 15
13
IM1
2
EFI No. 1
4
2F
W-B
A
EFI Relay
5
3
3
2D
2
1
5
2B
Y
P-L
13
IK3
J2
J/C
EH
A85256
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
395
05-206
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When a vehicle is brought into the workshop, leave it as it is. Do not change the vehicle condition. For example, do not tighten the fuel tank cap.
Do not disassemble the pump module.
A hand-held tester is required to conduct the following diagnostic troubleshooting procedure.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
CONFIRM DTC AND EVAP PRESSURE
Connect a hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to ON (do not start the engine).
Turn the tester ON.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
Read DTCs.
Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / VAPOR
PRESS.
Read the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) pressure displayed on the tester.
Result:
(g)
Display (DTC Output)
Test Results
P0451
P0452
P0453
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Pressure sensor
C
Less than 45 kpa (430 mmHg)
Wire harness/connector (ECM - pressure
sensor)
Pressure sensor
Short in ECM circuit
A
More than 120 kPa (900 mmHg)
Wire harness/connector (ECM - pressure
sensor)
Pressure sensor
Open in ECM circuit
B
B
Go to step 4
C
Go to EVAP INSPECTION PROCEDURE
(See page 05-317 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
396
05-207
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
ECM
Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance between PPMP terminal of the
ECM connector and the body ground.
E5
21 (PPMP)
A54404
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
10 Ω or less
Wire harness/connector (ECM - pressure sensor)
Short in pressure sensor circuit
A
10 kΩ or more
Wire harness/connector (ECM - pressure sensor)
Short in ECM circuit
B
(d)
Reconnect the ECM connector.
B
Go to step 7
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
397
05-208
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Remove the exhaust tail pipe.
Remove the heat insulator under the canister.
Disconnect the canister connector.
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Check the resistance between PPMP terminal of the ECM
connector and the body ground.
A85252
ECM
E5
21
A54404
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
10 kΩ or more
Short in pressure sensor circuit
A
10 Ω or less
Short in wire harness/connector (ECM - pressure sensor)
B
(f)
(g)
Reconnect the canister connector.
Reconnect the ECM connector.
A
Go to step 5
B
Go to step 6
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
398
05-209
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR(PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
Remove the exhaust tail pipe.
Remove the heat insulator under the canister.
Disconnect the canister connector.
Turn the ignition switch to ON.
Measure the voltage and resistance of the C17 connector.
Standard:
A85252
Wire Harness Side
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
C17-4 - Body ground
Between 4.5 V and 5.5 V
C17-3 - Body ground
Between 4.5 V and 5.5 V
C17-2 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
C17
Canister
A85258
Result:
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed To
Voltage and resistance within standard ranges
Open in pressure sensor circuit
A
Voltage and resistance outside standard ranges
Open in wire harness/connector (ECM - pressure sensor)
B
(g)
Reconnect the canister connector.
A
Go to step 5
B
Go to step 6
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
399
05-210
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
REPLACE PUMP MODULE
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
A85252
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
Remove the exhaust tail pipe.
Remove the heat insulator under the canister.
Disconnect the hoses and the connector.
Remove the 3 bolts and the pump module with the Oring.
Install a new pump module with a new O-ring.
Install the 3 bolts.
Connect the hoses and the connector.
Go to the next step before installing the exhaust tail pipe.
NEXT
6
Go to step 8
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
HINT:
If the exhaust tail pipe has been removed, go to the next step before reinstalling it.
NEXT
7
REPLACE ECM (see page 10-9 )
NEXT
8
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Go to step 8
Go to step 8
CONFIRM DTC (AFTER REPAIR)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to ON and turn the tester ON.
Wait for at least 60 seconds.
On the tester, select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /ENHANCED OBD II /DTC INFO /PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is displayed on the tester, the repair has been successfully completed.
NEXT
COMPLETED
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
400
05-21 1
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05IRA-02
DTC
P0455
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL
SYSTEM LEAK DETECTED (GROSS LEAK)
DTC
P0456
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL
SYSTEM LEAK DETECTED (VERY SMALL
LEAK)
DTC SUMMARY
DTC
P0455
P0456
Monitoring Items
Detection
Timings
Detection
Logic
Fuel tank cap (loose)
Leakage from EVAP line
(Canister - Fuel tank)
Leakage from EVAP line
(Purge VSV - Canister)
Pump module
Leakage from fuel tank
Leakage from canister
While
ignition
switch
OFF
2 trip
Same above
While
ignition
switch
OFF
2 trip
Malfunction Detection Conditions
EVAP gross leak
Vacuum pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in EVAP system and EVAP system pressure measured. 0.02 inch leak
pressure standard is measured at the start
and at the end of the leak check.
If stabilized pressure higher than [second
0.02 inch leak pressure standard x 0.2],
ECM determines that EVAP system has
large leakage.
EVAP small leak
Vacuum pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in EVAP system and EVAP system pressure measured. 0.02 inch leak
pressure standard is measured at the start
and at the end of the leak check.
If stabilized pressure larger than second
0.02 inch leak pressure, ECM determines
that EVAP system has small leakage.
Trouble Areas
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) Inspection Procedure (see page
05-317 ).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP Inspection Procedure (see page 05-317 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
401
05-212
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the electric vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions
based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35C (95F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned off,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35C (95F) 7 hours after the ignition switch is
turned off, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
-
Operations
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer, 5 hours (7 or 9.5 hours) after ignition switch turned to OFF.
A
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and EVAP system pressure measured by ECM in order to
register atmospheric pressure.
If EVAP pressure is not between 70 kPa and 110 kPa (525 mmHg and 825 mmHg), ECM
cancels EVAP system monitor.
-
10 seconds
B
First 0.02 inch leak
pressure measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through 0.02 inch orifice and them ECM checks if vacuum pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
C
EVAP system pressure measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system, and EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down the measured value as it will be used in the leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not stabilize within 15 minutes, ECM cancels EVAP system monitor.
15 minutes*
D
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then EVAP system pressure measured by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak
pressure measurement
Leak check is performed after second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard is measured.
If stabilized system pressure higher than second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, ECM
determines that EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured and then monitoring result recorded by ECM.
-
* If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement Operation B, E: 0.02 Inch Leak Pressure Measurement
Canister
Fuel Tank
OFF
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
OFF (vent)
Purge VSV: OFF
0.02 Inch Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Vacuum Pump: OFF
Air Filter
ON
Pump Module
Operation D: Purge VSV monitor
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
OFF
ON
ON (closed)
ON (closed)
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
Negative
Pressure
ON
A96746
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
402
05-213
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
(a) P0455: EVAP (Evaporative Emission) gross leak
In operation C, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and the EVAP
system pressure is measured. If the stabilized system pressure is higher than [second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard x 0.2] (near atmospheric pressure), the ECM determines that the EVAP system has a large
leakage, illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
(b) P0456: EVAP very small leak
In operation C, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and the EVAP
system pressure is measured. If the stabilized system pressure is higher than second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, the ECM determines that the EVAP system has a small leakage, illuminates the MIL and sets
the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when EVAP system Leaks:
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ON
Vent Valve
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
Vacuum Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
P0455
Positive
Negative
P0456
Second 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard x 0.2
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Sequence
Time
A
B
10
sec
60
sec
OK
C
D
E
Within 15 minutes
10
sec
60
sec
G38299
OBD II MONITOR SPECIFICATIONS
Monitor Strategy
Required Sensors/Components
Purge VSV and pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 15 minutes (varies with amount of fuel in tank)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
Typical Enabling Conditions
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
EVAP key-off monitor runs when all of the following conditions met
-
Atomspheric pressure
525 to 825 mmHg (70 to 110 kPa)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
Below 4 km/h (2.5 mph)
Ignition switch
OFF
Engine condition
Not running
Time after engine stopped
5 hours
FTP sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
Purge VSV
Not operated by scan tool
Vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
403
05-214
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before IG switch
OFF
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle is driven
5 min. or more
2. Purge flow
Executed
ECT
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
IAT
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
Example of re-start time
First time
7 hours
Second time
9 hours and 30 min.
Key-of f monitor sequence: 1 to 8
1. Atmospheric pressure
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
Atmospheric pressure change for 10 sec.
Within 2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) for 1 sec.
2. First reference pressure
Next sequence is run if all of following conditions met
Condition 1, 2 and 3
1. FTP when 4 sec. after reference pressure measurement
-7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa) or less
2. Reference pressure
-36.47 to -7.93 mmHg (-4.85 to -1.057 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
Saturated
3. Vent valve stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP change for 10 sec. after vent valve ON (closed)
2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) or more
4. Vacuum introduction and leak
Next sequence is run if both of following conditions met
Condition 1 and 2
1. Vacuum introduction time
Within 15 min.
2. FTP
FTP was saturated
5. Purge VSV stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP change for 10 sec. after purge VSV ON (open)
2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) or more
6. Second reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if all of following conditions met
Condition 1, 2, 3 and 4
1. FTP when 4 sec. after reference pressure measurement
-7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa) or less
2. Reference pressure
-36.47 to -7.93 mmHg (-4.85 to -1.057 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
Saturated
4. Reference pressure difference between first and second
Less than 5.25 mmHg (0.7 kPa)
7. Leak check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP when vacuum introduction was complete
Lower than second reference pressure
8. Atmospheric pressure
Monitor is complete if following
-
Atmospheric pressure difference between sequence 1 and 8
Within 2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa)
Typical Malfunction Thresholds
P0455: EVAP gross leak
FTP when vacuum introduction was complete
Higher than reference pressure x 0.2
P0456: EVAP small leak
FTP when vacuum introduction was complete
Between 1 and 2
Condition 1
Higher than second reference pressure
Condition 2
Lower than reference pressure x 0.2
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
404
05-215
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR RESULT (MODE 06)
Refer to page 05-317 for detailed information on Monitor Result.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
405
05-216
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVI-05
DTC
P0500
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ”A”
DTC
P0503
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ”A”
INTERMITTENT/ERRATIC/HIGH
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor detects the wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the skid control ECU. The
skid control ECU converts these wheel speed signals into a 4-pulse signal and outputs it to the ECM via
the combination meter. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
4-Pulse
From
Speed Sensor
Skid
Control
ECU
4-Pulse
Combination
Meter
ECM
A79413
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0500
P0503
The ECM detects the following conditions simultaneously for 2
seconds (1 trip detection logic):
No SPD (speed sensor) signal is output when ECM detects
NC (transmission counter gear) signal is more than 300 rpm.
Park/Neutral position switch is OFF (when shift lever is in
other than P and N positions)
Open or short in speed sensor circuit
Speed sensor
Combination meter
ECM
Skid control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM assumes that the vehicle is being driven when the transmission counter gear indicates more than
300 rpm and over 30 seconds have passed since the park/neutral position switch was turned OFF. If there
is no signal from the vehicle speed sensor with these conditions satisfied, the ECM concludes that the vehicle speed sensor is malfunctioning. The ECM will turn on the MIL and will set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0500: VSS Circuit
Required sensors/ components (Main)
Vehicle speed sensor (VSS), Combination meter, ABS ECU
Required sensors / components (Related)
Transmission counter gear Speed (CS) sensor, PNP switch, ECT sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
406
05-217
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Transmission counter gear speed
300 rpm or more
Engine condition
Running
Ignition switch
ON
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Starter
OFF
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 and 2
Condition 1:
-
Time after PNP switch turns from ON to OFF
2 sec. or more
ECT and ECT sensor
ECT is 20C (68F) or more and ECT sensor dose not malfunction (P0115 or
P0116)
Condition 2:
-
Time after PNP switch turns from ON to OFF
30 sec. or more
ECT and ECT sensor
ECT is less than 20C (68F) or ECT sensor fail is detected (P0115 or P0116)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Sensor signal
No pulse input
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
C12
Combination Meter
Center J/B
5V
W
13
9
3J
1
3B
9
Y
Y
IL2
J7
J/C
17
SPD
E6
1
A
BR
E9 E1
A
BR
EE
A85370
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
407
05-218
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a) Drive the vehicle and check if operation of the speedometer in the combination meter is normal.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is operating normally if the speedometer display is normal.
NG
CHECK SPEEDOMETER CIRCUIT
(See page 05-1885 )
OK
2
INSPECT ECM (SPD VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
SPD (+)
E6
ECM
Shift the lever to the neutral position.
Jack up the vehicle.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors as the wheel
is turned slowly.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E6-17 (SPD) - E9-1 (E1)
Generated intermittently
HINT:
The output voltage should fluctuate up and down similarly to the
diagram on the left when the wheel is turned slowly.
4.5
to 5.5 V
0V
Turn Wheel
A67446
A62954
A85537
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
408
05-219
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0504
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVK-05
BRAKE SWITCH ”A”/”B” CORRELATION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
In addition to turning on the stop lamp, the stop lamp switch signals are used for a variety of engine, transmission, and suspension functions as well as being an input for diagnostic checks. It is important that the switch
operates properly, therefore this switch is designed with two complementary signal outputs: STP and ST1.
The ECM analyzes these signal outputs to detect malfunctions in the stop lamp switch.
HINT:
Normal condition is as shown in the table.
DTC No.
P0504
Signal
Brake pedal released
In transition
Brake pedal depressed
STP
OFF
ON
ON
ST1
ON
ON
OFF
DTC Detection Condition
Conditions (a), (b) and (c) continue for 0.5 seconds or more:
(a) Ignition switch ON
(b) Brake pedal released
(c) STP signal is OFF when the ST1 signal is OFF
Trouble Area
Short in stop lamp switch signal circuit
STOP fuse
Stop lamp switch
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
409
05-220
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
S15
Stop Lamp Switch Assy
Y
Instrument
Panel J/B Assy
1
12
4M
3
4L
B
2
ECM
Passenger Side J/B
1
19
BR
STP
12
E6 ST1-
V
3
E6
4
1E
P
STOP
J6
J/C
1
Passenger Side J/B
1A
1
4E
P
E
E
4
4M
W
B
F7
FL Block Assy
2
1
I15
Ignition Switch
ALT
AM2
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
1
L-Y
10
IC1
Y
AM2
7
GR
IG2
6
1
IGN
6
1G
1C
1
W
1
BR
E9 E1
FL
Main
A
J7
J/C
A
BR
Battery
EE
A90301
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
410
05-221
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Hand-held tester:
1
(a)
CHECK STOP LAMP (OPERATION)
Check if the stop lamps turn on and off normally when the brake pedal is depressed and released.
OK:
The stop lamps turn on when you depress the brake pedal.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH
CIRCUIT
OK
2
INSPECT STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY (RESISTANCE)
(a)
Free
Pushed in
2
4
1
3
A82517
Measure the resistance of the switch terminals.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Switch pin free
1-2
Below 1.5 V
Switch pin free
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
1-2
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
3-4
Below 1.5 V
NG
REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
411
05-222
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (STP SIGNAL, ST1 VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Brake Pedal
Depressed
Brake Pedal
Released
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL /
STOP LIGHT SW. Read the value.
Standard:
Brake Pedal Condition
Specified Condition
Depressed
STP Signal ON
Released
STP Signal OFF
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Brake Pedal Condition
Specified Condition
E6-12 (ST1) - E9-1 (E1)
Tester Connection
Depressed
Below 1.5 V
E6-12 (ST1) - E9-1 (E1)
Released
7.5 to 14 V
ST1 (+)
E6
ECM
A72880
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
412
05-223
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STOP LAMP SWITCH - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
Disconnect the S15 stop lamp switch connector.
Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
S15
Stop Lamp Switch
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S15-1 - E6-19 (STP)
S15-4 - E6-12 (ST1)
Below 1 Ω
S15-1 or E6-19 (STP) - Body ground
S15-4 or E6-12 (ST1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E6
ECM
ST1
STP
NG
Y
A56986
A67404
A87771
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
(a)
CHECK STOP LAMP (OPERATION)
Check if the stop lamps turn on and off normally when the brake pedal is depressed and released.
OK:
The stop lamps turn on when you depress the brake pedal.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH
CIRCUIT
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
413
05-224
DIAGNOSTICS
2
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
(a)
Free
-
Pushed in
1
2
Measure the resistance of the switch terminals.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Switch pin free
1-2
Below 1 Ω
Switch pin free
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
1-2
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3
4
A82517
NG
REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (STP, ST1 VOLTAGE)
Brake Pedal
Depressed
(a)
(b)
Brake Pedal
Released
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Brake Pedal Condition
Specified Condition
Depressed
7.5 to 14 V
E6-19 (STP) - E9-1 (E1)
Released
Below 1.5 V
E6-12 (ST1) - E9-1 (E1)
Depressed
Below 1.5 V
E6-12 (ST1) - E9-1 (E1)
Released
7.5 to 14 V
E6-19 (STP) - E9-1 (E1)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
ST1 (+)
STP (+)
E6
ECM
OK
A72880
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
414
05-225
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STOP LAMP SWITCH - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
Disconnect the S15 stop lamp switch connector.
Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
S15
Stop Lamp Switch
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S15-1 - E6-19 (STP)
S15-4 - E6-12 (ST1)
Below 1 Ω
S15-1 or E6-19 (STP) - Body ground
S15-4 or E6-12 (ST1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E6
ECM
ST1
STP
Y
A56986
A67404
NG
A87771
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
415
05-226
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0505
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVL-05
IDLE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The idle speed is controlled by the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS).
The ETCS is composed of the throttle motor, which operates the throttle valve, and the throttle position sensor, which detects the opening angle of the throttle valve.
The ECM controls the throttle motor to provide the proper throttle valve opening angle to obtain the target
idle speed.
The ECM regulates the idle speed by opening and closing the throttle valve using the ETCS. The ECM concludes that the idle speed control ECM function is malfunctioning if: 1) the actual idle RPM varies more than
the specified amount five times or more during a drive cycle, or 2) a learning value of the idle speed control
remains at the maximum or minimum five times or more during a drive cycle. The ECM will turn on the MIL
and set a DTC.
Example:
If the actual idle RPM varies from the target idle RPM by more than 200*1 rpm five times during a drive cycle,
the ECM will turn on the MIL and will set a DTC.
*1: RPM threshold varies with engine load.
Large
Idle Engine
RPM
Target RPM
Maximum
Learning Value
of the Idle Speed
Control
0
Actual Idle RPM
Minimum
Small
Time
Time
A82389
DTC No.
P0505
DTC Detection Condition
Idle speed continues to vary greatly from target speed
Trouble Area
Electronic throttle control system
Air induction system
PCV hose connection
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
416
05-227
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
IAC Functional Check
Required sensors / components (Main)
ETCS (Electrical throttle control system)
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP sensor, ECT sensor, and VSS
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 min.
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
Engine
Running
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the Conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Frequency that both of the following conditions (a) and (b)
are met:
5 times
(a) Engine RPM - Target engine RPM
Less than -100 rpm or more than 150 rpm
(b) Vehicle condition
Stop after vehicle was driven at 10 km/h (6.25 mph) or more
2. Frequency that both of the following conditions (a) and (b)
are met:
Once
(a) IAC flow rate learning value
Below 1.3 L/second or above 4.51 L/second
(b) Engine RPM - Target engine RPM
Less than -100 rpm or more than 150 rpm
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
417
05-228
DIAGNOSTICS
1
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0505)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
Only P0505 is output
A
P0505 and other DTCs are output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0505 are output, perform the troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-48 )
A
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF PCV HOSE
OK: PCV hose is connected correctly and PCV hose has no damage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
3
(a)
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Check for vacuum leaks in the air induction system.
OK: No leak in air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
OK
CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL SYSTEM (See page 10-1 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
418
05-229
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0560
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVM-05
SYSTEM VOLTAGE
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The battery supplies electricity to the ECM even when the ignition switch is OFF. This electricity allows the
ECM to store data such as DTC history, freeze frame data, fuel trim values and other data. If the battery
voltage falls below a minimum level, the ECM will conclude that there is a fault in the power supply circuit.
The next time the engine starts, the ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC will be set.
DTC No.
P0560
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Open in back-up power source circuit
ECM
Open in ECM back-up power source circuit
(1 trip detection logic)
HINT:
If DTC P0560 is present, the ECM will not store other DTCs.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0560: ECM system voltage
Required sensors / components (Main)
ECM
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
3 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate (MIL will illuminate after the next engine start)
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
ECM power source
Less than 3.5 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
419
05-230
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Engine Room J/B
1 EFI NO. 1 7
2I
2B
W
3
B-W
11
BR
IK2
F7
FL Block Assy
BR
3
E5
BATT
1
E9
E1
1
W
A
J7
J/C
FL
Main
A
BR
Battery
EE
A90302
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT FUSE (EFI NO. 1)
(a)
(b)
Engine Room J/B
EFI NO. 1 fuse
A90343
Remove the EFI NO. 1 fuse from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance of the EFI NO. 1 fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
OK
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
420
05-231
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM (BATT VOLTAGE)
(a)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
BATT (+)
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-3 (BATT) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
E5
ECM
A67446
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
421
05-232
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - EFI NO. 1 FUSE, EFI NO. 1 FUSE - BATTERY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
Check the wire harness between the EFI NO. 1 fuse and
ECM.
(1) Remove the EFI NO. 1 fuse from the engine room
J/B.
(2) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Engine Room J/B
EFI NO. 1 Fuse
Tester Connection
E5
ECM
Specified Condition
J/B EFI NO. 1 fuse terminal 2 - E5-3 (BATT)
Below 1 Ω
J/B EFI NO. 1 fuse terminal 2 or E5-3 (BATT) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
BATT
Y
A80025
A67445
A92625
(b)
Wire Harness Side
Engine Room J/B
Check the wire harness between the EFI NO. 1 fuse and
battery.
(1) Remove the EFI NO. 1 fuse from the engine room
J/B.
(2) Disconnect the battery positive cable.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
EFI NO. 1 Fuse
A80025
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery positive cable - J/B EFI NO. 1 fuse terminal 1
Below 1 Ω
Battery positive cable or J/B EFI NO. 1 fuse terminal 1
- Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A92626
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE ENGINE ROOM J/B
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
422
05-233
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVN-05
DTC
P0604
INTERNAL CONTROL MODULE RANDOM
ACCESS MEMORY (RAM) ERROR
DTC
P0606
ECM/PCM PROCESSOR
DTC
P0607
CONTROL MODULE PERFORMANCE
DTC
P0657
ACTUATOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE
CIRCUIT/OPEN
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM continuously monitors its internal memory status, internal circuits, and output signals to the throttle
actuator. This self-check ensures that the ECM is functioning properly. If any malfunction is detected, the
ECM will set the appropriate DTC and illuminate the MIL.
The ECM memory status is diagnosed by internal ”mirroring” of the main CPU and the sub CPU to detect
random access memory (RAM) errors. The two CPUs also perform continuous mutual monitoring. The ECM
sets a DTC if: 1) outputs from the 2 CPUs are different and deviate from the standards, 2) the signals to the
throttle actuator deviate from the standards, 3) a malfunction is found in the throttle actuator supply voltage,
and 4) any other ECM malfunction is found.
DTC No.
P0604
P0606
P0607
P0657
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
ECM internal error
(1trip detection logic)
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0604: RAM errors
P0606: CPU malfunction
P0607: ECM range check
P0657: ETCS (Electrical throttle control) power supply circuit in ECM
Required sensors / components (Main)
ECM
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
Within 1 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
RAM Error P0604:
RAM
RAM check failure
CPU malfunction P0606:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Difference between TP of main CPU and TP of sub CPU
0.3 V or more
2. Difference between APP of main CPU and APP of sub
CPU
0.3 V or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
423
05-234
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
ECM range check P0607:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. All of the following conditions are met:
Conditions (a), (b) and (c)
(a) CPU reset
1 time or more
(b) Difference between TP and APP learned
0.4 V or more
(c) Electronic throttle actuator
OFF
2. CPU reset
2 times or more
ETCS power supply circuit in ECM P0657:
ETCS power supply when ignition switch turns from OFF to
ON
7 V or more
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
424
05-235
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0617
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVO-05
STARTER RELAY CIRCUIT HIGH
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
While the engine is being cranked, the battery positive voltage is applied to terminal STA of the ECM.
If the vehicle is being driven and the ECM detects the starter control signal (STA), the ECM concludes that
the starter control circuit is malfunctioning. The ECM will turn on the MIL and will set a DTC.
DTC No.
P0617
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met and the battery (+B)
voltage 10.5 V or more is applied for 20 seconds:
(1 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h)
(b) Engine revolution greater than 1,000 rpm
(c) STA signal ON
Short in PNP switch assy circuit
PNP switch assy
Ignition switch
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0617: Starter signal
Required sensors / components (Main)
Starter relay and PNP switch
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP sensor and vehicle speed sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
20 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
20 km/h (12.4 mph) or more
Engine RPM
1,000 rpm or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Starter signal
ON
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
425
05-236
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
I15
Ignition Switch
W
2 AM1
AM2
Instrument
Panel J/B
Assy
ECM
3
IC1
B
ST1 1
ST2
7
2
8
Engine
Room R/B
No. 2
B-W
Y
1C 6
2
1
AM1
1
2
IC1
1
STARTER
2
IC1
Engine
Room R/B
No. 2
1A 1
B-Y
2
L
L-W
B-W
3
2
EB2
2
B-R
4
P1
PNP
Switch
5
L-Y
B
5
F7
2 FL Block Assy
1
4 EB2
STARTER
Relay
2
3
B
ALT
AM2
2
B
17
B
2
E7
STA
10
1
W-R
W
4
FL
Main
EB1
B-W
B
1
S2
BR
W-B
A
S1
E1
A
J2
J/C
1
1
E9
J7
J/C
A
BR
Starter
Battery
EH
EE
A90303
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
426
05-237
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Hand-held tester:
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (STA SIGNAL)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn ON the ignition switch. Push the hand-held tester main switch.
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST
/ ALL / STARTER SIG. Read the values.
Result:
Ignition Switch Condition
ON
START
STA signal
OFF
ON
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
NG
2
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY (See page 05-922 )
OK:
When shift lever is in the N position, the PNP switch is ON.
When shift lever is in the P position, the PNP switch is OFF.
NG
REPLACE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (See page 40-3 ) (Go to step 3 AFTER REPLACEMENT)
OK
3
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (STA SIGNAL)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn ON the ignition switch. Push the hand-held tester main switch.
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST
/ ALL / STARTER SIG. Read the values.
Result:
Ignition Switch Condition
ON
START
STA signal
OFF
ON
OK
SYSTEM OK
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
427
05-238
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSY
(a)
AM1
I15
Ignition
Switch
ST2
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
AM2
ST1
Measure the resistance of the ignition switch terminals.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
LOCK
1-2
7-8
10 kΩ or higher
START
1-2
7-8
Below 1 Ω
NG
A56879
REPLACE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSY (Go to next step 5 AFTER REPLACEMENT)
OK
5
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (STA SIGNAL)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn ON the ignition switch. Push the hand-held tester main switch.
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST
/ ALL / STARTER SIG. Read the values.
Result:
Ignition Switch Condition
ON
START
STA Signal
OFF
ON
OK
SYSTEM OK
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
428
05-239
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
OBD II scan tool (excluding Hand-held Tester):
1
INSPECT ECM
STA (+)
E7
ECM
(a)
(b)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
E7-17 (STA) - E9-1 (E1)
Ignition switch ON
0V
E7-17 (STA) - E9-1 (E1)
Engine cranking
6 V or more
OK
Specified Condition
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
A76903
NG
2
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY (See page 05-922 )
NG
REPLACE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (See page 40-3 ) (Go to next step 3 AFTER
REPLACEMENT)
OK
3
INSPECT ECM
(a)
STA (+)
E7
ECM
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
A76903
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
E7-17 (STA) - E9-1 (E1)
Ignition switch ON
0V
E7-17 (STA) - E9-1 (E1)
Engine cranking
6 V or more
OK
Specified Condition
SYSTEM OK
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
429
05-240
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSY
(a)
AM1
I15
Ignition
Switch
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
ST2
ST1
Measure the resistance of the ignition switch terminals.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
LOCK
1-2
7-8
10 kΩ or higher
START
1-2
7-8
Below 1 Ω
NG
AM2
A56879
REPLACE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSY
OK
5
INSPECT ECM
(a)
STA (+)
E7
ECM
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
A76903
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
E7-17 (STA) - E9-1 (E1)
Ignition switch ON
0V
E7-17 (STA) - E9-1 (E1)
Engine cranking
6 V or more
OK
Specified Condition
SYSTEM OK
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
430
05-241
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0630
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05MOK-01
VIN NOT PROGRAMMED OR MISMATCH ECM/PCM
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC P0630 is set when the Vehicle Indication Number (VIN) is not stored in the ECM or the input VIN is not
accurate. Input the VIN with the hand-held tester (see page 05-12 ).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
VIN is not stored in ECM
Input VIN in ECM is not accurate
P0630
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0630: VIN not programed
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
ECM
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Stater
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
VIN code
Not programmed
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VIN code
Programmed
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ CURRENT DTC
NOTICE:
If P0630 is present, the VIN must be input to the ECM using the hand-held tester. However, all DTCs
are cleared automatically by the tester when inputting the VIN. If DTCs other than P0630 are present,
check them first.
NEXT
2
INPUT VIN WITH HAND-HELD TESTER (See page 05-12 )
NEXT
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
431
05-242
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0705
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
055UU-10
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR CIRCUIT
MALFUNCTION (PRNDL INPUT)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the shift lever is in the N or P position: 1) the Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch turns on, and 2) ECM
terminal NSW is grounded to the body ground via the starter relay and voltage becomes 0 V. When the shift
lever is in the D, 2, L or R position: 1) the PNP switch turns off, and 2) ECM terminal NSW receives current
and becomes the voltage of the ECM internal power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air-fuel ratio correction
and for idle speed control (estimated control).
DTC No.
P0705
DTC Detection Condition
2 or more switches are ON simultaneously at R, N, D, 2 and L
positions (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Short in PNP switch circuit
PNP switch
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0705, use the hand-held tester to confirm the PNP switch signal in the ALL menu
(to reach the ALL menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0705 on page 05-922 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to DTC P0705 on page 05-922 .
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
432
05-243
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVQ-05
DTC
P2102
THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL MOTOR
CIRCUIT LOW
DTC
P2103
THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL MOTOR
CIRCUIT HIGH
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle actuator is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor which is mounted on the
throttle body. The throttle position sensor provides feedback to the ECM. This feedback allows the ECM to
control the throttle actuator and monitor the throttle opening angle in response to driver inputs.
HINT:
This Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) does not use a throttle cable.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2102
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2.0 seconds:
(a) Throttle actuator output duty 80 % or more
(b) Throttle actuator current 0.5 A or less
(1 trip detection logic)
Open in throttle actuator circuit
Throttle actuator
ECM
P2103
Either of following conditions is met:
Throttle actuator current 10 A or more (0.1 seconds)
Throttle actuator current 7 A or more (0.6 seconds)
(1 trip detection logic)
Short in throttle actuator circuit
Throttle actuator
Throttle valve
Throttle body assy
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the flow of electrical current through the electronic throttle actuator, and detects malfunctions or open circuits in the throttle motor based on the value of the electrical current. When the current deviates from the standard, the ECM concludes that there is a fault in the throttle motor. Or, if the throttle valve
is not functioning properly (for example, stuck on), the ECM concludes that there is a fault and turns on the
MIL and a DTC is set.
Example:
When the current is more than 10 A, or the current is less than 0.5 A when the actuator driving duty ratio
is more than 80 %, the ECM concludes that the current is deviated from the standard, turns on the MIL and
a DTC is set.
FAIL-SAFE
If the ETCS has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle actuator. The throttle control valve
returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16) by the force of the return spring. The ECM
then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in
accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
433
05-244
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2102: Throttle actuator current (low current)
P2103: Throttle actuator current (high current)
Required sensors / components (Main)
Throttle actuator
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
P2102:
Throttle actuator duty ratio
80 % or more
Throttle actuator power supply
8 V or more
P2103:
Throttle actuator power supply
8 V or more
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2102:
Throttle actuator current
Less than 0.5 A
P2103:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Hybrid IC diagnosis signal
Fail ( for 0.1 sec.)
2. Hybrid IC current limiter port
Fail (for 0.6 sec.)
WIRING DIAGRAM
T13
Throttle Actuator
ECM
Shielded
M+ 2
B
3
E9
M+
M-
W
2
E9
M-
1
17
E9 GE01
A87825
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
434
05-245
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY ASSY (THROTTLE ACTUATOR)
(a)
(b)
T13
Throttle Actuator
M+
M-
Disconnect the T13 throttle actuator connector.
Measure the resistance of the throttle actuator terminals.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T13-2 (M+) - T13-1 (M-)
0.3 to 100 Ω (20 C (68F))
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSY
A59778
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (THROTTLE ACTUATOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
T13
Throttle Actuator
M-
Disconnect the T13 throttle actuator connector.
Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
M+
E9
ECM
MM+
Y
B53781
A81698
A85540
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T13-2 (M+) - E9-3 (M+)
T13-1 (M-) - E9-2 (M-)
Below 1 Ω
T13-2 (M+) or E9-3 (M+) - Body ground
T13-1 (M-) or E9-2 (M-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
435
05-246
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY ASSY
Visually check for foreign objects between the throttle valve and the housing.
Also, check if the valve can open and close smoothly.
OK: The throttle valve is not contaminated with foreign objects and can move smoothly.
NG
REMOVE FOREIGN OBJECT AND CLEAN
THROTTLE BODY
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
436
05-247
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVS-05
DTC
P2111
THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL SYSTEM
- STUCK OPEN
DTC
P2112
THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL SYSTEM
- STUCK CLOSED
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle actuator is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve using gears. The
opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor, which is mounted on the throttle
body. The throttle position sensor provides feedback to the ECM to control the throttle actuator and set the
throttle valve angle in response to driver inputs.
HINT:
This Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) does not use a throttle cable.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2111
Throttle valve locked during ECM order to close
(1 trip detection logic)
P2112
Throttle valve locked during ECM order to open
(1 trip detection logic)
Throttle actuator circuit
Throttle actuator
Throttle body
Throttle valve
Same as DTC No. P2111
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM concludes that there is a malfunction of the ETCS when the throttle valve remains at a fixed angle
despite high drive current from the ECM. The ECM will turn on the MIL and will set a DTC.
FAIL-SAFE
If the ETCS has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle actuator. The throttle control valve
returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16) by the force of the return spring. The ECM
then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in
accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2111: Throttle actuator stuck open
P2112: Throttle actuator stuck closed
Required sensors/ components (Main)
Throttle actuator
Required sensors/ components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
437
05-248
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
P2111:
Throttle motor current
2 A or more
Throttle actuator close duty ratio
80 % or more
P2112:
Throttle motor current
2 A or more
Throttle actuator open duty ratio
80 % or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TP (throttle position) sensor voltage change for 0.016 second
Less than 0.1 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2102 on page 05-243 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P2111 or P2112
A
P2111 or P2112 and other DTCs
B
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART (See page
05-48 )
A
2
CHECK THROTTLE BODY ASSY (VISUALLY CHECK THROTTLE VALVE)
Check for contamination between the throttle valve and the housing. If necessary, clean the throttle body.
And check that the throttle valve moves smoothly.
OK: The throttle valve is not contaminated with foreign objects and can move smoothly.
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSY (See page
10-6 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
438
05-249
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK DTC OUTPUT
Clear the DTC (See page 05-38 ).
Start the engine, and depress and release the accelerator pedal quickly (fully open and fully close).
Read the DTC.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
No DTC
A
P2111 and/or P2112
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
A
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS (See page 05-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
439
05-250
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P2118
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVT-05
THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL MOTOR
CURRENT RANGE/PERFORMANCE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has a dedicated power supply circuit. The voltage (+BM) is
monitored and when the voltage is low (less than 4 V), the ECM concludes that the ETCS has a fault and
current to the throttle actuator is cut.
When the voltage becomes unstable, the ETCS itself becomes unstable. For this reason, when the voltage
is low, the current to the actuator is cut. If repairs are made and the system has returned to normal, turn the
ignition switch OFF. The ECM then allows current to flow to the actuator and actuator can be restarted.
HINT:
This ETCS does not use a throttle cable.
ECM
From
Battery
ETCS
+BM
Actuator Control
Circuit
Throttle Actuator
M+
M-
ME01
A85832
DTC No.
P2118
DTC Detection Condition
Open in ETCS power source circuit
(1 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Open in ETCS power source circuit
ETCS fuse
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the battery supply voltage applied to the electronic throttle actuator. When the power
supply voltage drops below the threshold, the ECM concludes that the power supply circuit has an open
circuit. A DTC is set and the MIL is turned on.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
440
05-251
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
FAIL-SAFE
If the ETCS has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle actuator. The throttle control valve
returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16) by the force of the return spring. The ECM
then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in
accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop and
the system will return to normal.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2118: Throttle actuator power supply
Required sensors / components (Main)
Throttle actuator, ETCS fuse
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.8 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
Battery voltage
More than 8 V
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Throttle actuator power supply voltage
Less than 4 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Throttle actuator power supply voltage
9 to 14 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
441
05-252
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
R
4
W
IC1
6
E6
+BM
2
2
ETCS
Engine Room
R/B No. 2
1
2
T13
Throttle Actuator
Shielded
M+ 2
B
3
E9
M+
1
W
2
E9
M-
W
M3
F7
FL Block Assy
17
E9 GE01
1
W
W-B
FL
Main
Battery
4
E9
ME01
EF
A90304
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
442
05-253
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK FUSE (ETCS)
(a)
(b)
Engine Room R/B No. 2
ETCS Fuse
Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room R/B No. 2.
Measure the resistance of the ETCS fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
NG
A92628
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
INSPECT ECM (+BM VOLTAGE)
(a)
ME01 (-)
E9
ECM
+BM (+)
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E6-6 (+BM) - E9-4 (ME01)
9 to 14 V
E6
ECM
A67446
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
443
05-254
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - ETCS FUSE, ETCS FUSE - BATTERY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
Engine Room R/B No. 2
Check the wire harness between the ETCS fuse and
ECM.
(1) Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room R/B
No. 2.
(2) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R/B No. 2 ETCS fuse terminal 2 - E6-6 (+BM)
Below 1 Ω
R/B No. 2 ETCS fuse terminal 2 or E6-6 (+BM) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
ETCS Fuse
E6
ECM
+BM
A80017
A67404
A92627
(b)
Wire Harness Side
Engine Room R/B No. 2
ETCS Fuse
Check the wire harness between the ETCS fuse and battery.
(1) Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room R/B
No. 2.
(2) Disconnect the battery positive cable.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery positive cable - R/B No. 2 ETCS fuse terminal 1
Below 1 Ω
Battery positive cable or R/B No. 2 ETCS fuse terminal 1
- Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A92628
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK NO.2
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
444
05-255
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P2119
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVU-05
THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL
THROTTLE BODY RANGE/PERFORMANCE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) is composed of a throttle actuator that operates the throttle
valve, a throttle position sensor that detects the opening angle of the throttle valve, an accelerator pedal
position sensor that detects the accelerator pedal position, and the ECM that controls the ETCS system.
The ECM operates the throttle actuator to position the throttle valve for proper response to driver inputs. The
throttle position sensor, which is mounted on the throttle body, detects the opening angle of the throttle valve
and provides this signal to the ECM so that the ECM can regulate the throttle actuator.
DTC No.
P2119
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Throttle opening angle continues to vary greatly from target
throttle opening angle
(1 trip detection logic)
Electronic throttle control system
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM determines the ”actual” throttle angle based on the throttle position sensor signal. The ”actual”
throttle position is compared to the ”target” throttle position commanded by the ECM. If the difference between these two values exceeds a specified limit, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the ETCS system. The
ECM turns on the MIL and a DTC is set.
FAIL-SAFE
If the ETCS has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle actuator. The throttle control valve
returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16) by the force of the return spring. The ECM
then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in
accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2119: ETCS malfunction
Required sensors / components (Main)
Throttle actuator
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
1 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference between ”target TP (Throttle position)” and ”actual TP”
0.3 V or more
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2102 on page 05-243 .
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
445
05-256
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2119)
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only P2119 is output
A
P2119 and other codes are output
B
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART (See page
05-48 )
A
2
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUT REOCCURS
(a) Clear the DTC (see page 05-38 ).
(b) Allow the engine to idle for 15 seconds.
(c) Pull the hand brake and shift the gear to D.
(d) Depress the brake pedal securely and the accelerator pedal fully for 5 seconds.
(e) Read the DTC.
HINT:
Actual throttle position (TP) sensor voltage can be confirmed using the hand-held tester [DATA LIST / ALL
/ THROTTLE POS #1].
OK: No DTC is output.
OK
NORMAL
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
446
05-257
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ITG-02
DTC
P2120
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”D” CIRCUIT
DTC
P2122
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”D” CIRCUIT LOW INPUT
DTC
P2123
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”D” CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
DTC
P2125
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”E” CIRCUIT
DTC
P2127
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”E” CIRCUIT LOW INPUT
DTC
P2128
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”E” CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
DTC
P2138
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”D”/”E” VOLTAGE
CORRELATION
HINT:
This is the repair procedure for the ”accelerator pedal position sensor”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
447
05-258
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
HINT:
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
Magnet
IC No. 1
ECM
VPA
EPA
VCPA
VPA2
EPA2
IC No. 2
VCP2
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor Output Voltage (V)
This Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) does not use a throttle cable.
This description is for the accelerator pedal position sensor.
The Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor is mounted on the accelerator pedal to detect the angle of the
accelerator pedal. This sensor is electronically controlled and uses Hall-effect elements.
In the accelerator pedal position sensor, the voltage applied to terminals VPA and VPA2 of the ECM changes
between 0 V and 5 V in proportion to the angle of the accelerator pedal. The VPA is a signal to indicate the
actual accelerator pedal angle and is used for the engine control. VPA2 is used to detect malfunctions of
the sensor itself.
The ECM monitors the accelerator pedal angle from VPA and VPA2 signal outputs, and controls the throttle
motor based on these signals.
*1
*2
5
3.4 to 5.3
2.6 to 4.5
1.6
0.8
0
Usable Range
25
Accelerator Pedal Turning Angle (deg)
Magnet
*1: Accelerator Pedal Released
*2: Accelerator Pedal Fully Depressed
A19694
A19803
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
448
05-259
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
DTC Detection Condition
(All of the following are 1 trip detection logic)
DTC No.
Trouble Area
P2120
Condition (a) continues for 0.5 sec. or more:
(a) VPA is 0.2 V or less or VPA is 4.8 V or more
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
P2122
VPA is 0.2 V or less for 0.5 sec. or more when VPA2 output
indicates accelerator pedal is opened
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in VCP1 circuit
VPA circuit open or ground short
ECM
P2123
Condition (a) continues for 2.0 sec. or more:
(a) VPA is 4.8 V or more
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in EPA circuit
ECM
P2125
Condition (a) continues for 0.5 sec. or more:
(a) (VPA2 is 0.5 V or less) or (VPA2 is 4.8 V or more)
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
P2127
VPA2 is 0.5 V or less for 0.5 sec. or more when VPA output
indicates accelerator pedal is opened
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in VCP2 circuit
VPA2 circuit open or ground short
ECM
P2128
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2.0 sec. or more:
(a) VPA2 is 4.8 V or more
(b) VPA is 0.2 V or more and VPA is 3.45 V or less
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in EPA2 circuit
ECM
P2138
Condition (a) or (b) continues for 2.0 sec. or more:
(a) Difference between VPA and VPA2 is 0.02 V or less
(b) VPA is 0.2 V or less and VPA2 is 0.5 V or less
VPA and VPA2 circuit are short circuited
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P2120, P2122, P2123, P2125, P2127, P2128 and P2138, use the hand-held tester
or the OBD II scan tool to confirm the accelerator pedal position sensor output voltage.
Accelerator pedal position expressed as voltage output
Accelerator pedal released
Trouble Area
Accelerator pedal depressed
ACCEL POS #1
ACCEL POS #2
ACCEL POS #1
VCP circuit open
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
ACCEL POS #2
0 to 0.2 V
VPA circuit open or ground short
0 to 0.2 V
1.2 to 2.0 V
0 to 0.2 V
3.4 to 5.3 V
VPA2 circuit open or ground short
0.5 to 1.1 V
0 to 0.2 V
2.6 to 4.5 V
0 to 0.2 V
EPA circuit open
4.5 to 5.5 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
When VPA or VPA2 deviates from the standard, or the difference between the voltage outputs of the two
sensors is less than the threshold, the ECM concludes that there is a defect in the accelerator pedal position
sensor. The ECM turns on the MIL and a DTC is set.
Example:
The voltage output of the VPA is below 0.2 V or exceeds 4.8 V.
FAIL-SAFE
The accelerator pedal position sensor has 2 (main and sub) sensor circuits. If a malfunction occurs in either
of the sensor circuits, the ECM detects the abnormal signal voltage difference between the 2 sensor circuits
and switches to fail-safe mode. In fail-safe mode, the remaining circuit is used to calculate the accelerator
pedal opening angle to allow the vehicle to continue driving.
If both circuits malfunction, the ECM regards the opening angle of the accelerator pedal to be fully closed.
In this case, the throttle valve will remain closed as if the engine is idling.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
449
05-260
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2120: APP (Accelerator pedal position) Sensor 1 range check (chattering)
P2122: APP sensor 1 range check (low voltage)
P2123: APP sensor 1 range check (high voltage)
P2125: APP sensor 2 range check (chattering)
P2127: APP sensor 2 range check (low voltage)
P2128: APP sensor 2 range check (high voltage)
P2138: APP sensor range check (correlation)
Required sensors / components (Main)
APP sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 sec.: P2120, P2122, P2125 and P2127
2 sec.: P2123, P2128 and P2138
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2120:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. VPA1 voltage when VPA2 is 0.97 or more
0.2 V or less
2. VPA1 voltage
4.8 V or more
P2122:
VPA1 voltage when VPA2 is 0.97 or more
0.2 V or less
P2123:
VPA1 voltage
4.8 V or more
P2125:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. VPA2 voltage when VPA1 is 0.97 or more
0.5 V or less
2. VPA2 voltage when VPA1 is 0.2 to 3.45 V
4.8 V or more
P2127:
VPA2 voltage when VPA1 is 0.97 or more
0.5 V or less
P2128:
VPA2 voltage when VPA1 is 0.2 to 3.45 V
4.8 V or more
P2138:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Difference betrween VPA 1 and VPA2 voltage
0.02 V or less
Condition 2
-
VPA1 voltage
0.2 V or less
VPA2 voltage
0.5 V or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VPA voltage
0.5 to 4.5 V
VPA2 voltage
1.2 to 4.8 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
450
05-261
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
A27
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
VPA
EPA
VCPA
VPA2
EPA2
VCP2
ECM
6
B
22
VPA
E5
5
R
28
E5
4
G
EPA
26
VCPA
E5
3
W
23
VPA2
E5
2
BR
29
E5
EPA2
27 VCP2
E5
L
1
A80021
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Hand-held tester:
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (ACCEL POS #1 AND ACCEL POS #2)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Depressed
Released
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ETCS
/ ACCEL POS #1 and ACCEL POS #2” and read its value
displayed on the hand-held tester.
Standard:
Accelerator Pedal
ACCEL POS #1
ACCEL POS #2
Released
0.5 to 1.1 V
1.2 to 2.0 V
Depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
3.4 to 5.3 V
FI7052
OK
Go to step 5
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
451
05-262
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
A27
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
Disconnect the A27 sensor connector.
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
VCP2 EPA2
VPA2
VCPA EPA
VPA VCP2
VPA
EPA
VCPA
VPA2
EPA2
VCP2
VPA
E5 VCPA
ECM
(A27-6)
(A27-5)
(A27-4)
(A27-3)
(A27-2)
(A27-1)
-
Specified Condition
VPA (E5-22)
EPA (E5-28)
VCPA (E5-26)
VPA2 (E5-23)
EPA2 (E5-29)
VCP2 (E5-27)
Below 1 Ω
VPA (A27-6) or VPA (E5-22) - Body ground
EPA (A27-5) or EPA (E5-28) - Body ground
VCPA (A27-4) or VCPA (E5-26) - Body ground
VPA2 (A27-3) or VPA2 (E5-23) - Body ground
EPA2 (A27-2) or EPA2 (E5-29) - Body ground
VCP2 (A27-1) or VCP2 (E5-27) - Body ground
VPA2
EPA2
10 kΩ or higher
EPA
B53781
A67445
A92629
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (VCPA AND VCP2 VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
A27
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
EPA2 (-)
A19521
A53765
EPA (-)
VCP2 (+)
VCPA (+)
Disconnect the A27 sensor connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VCPA (E5-26) - EPA (E5-28)
VCP2 (E5-27) - EPA2 (E5-29)
4.5 to 5.5 V
E5
ECM
A92544
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
452
05-263
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY (See page 10-1 1)
GO
5
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
READ OUTPUT DTC (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR DTCS ARE
OUTPUT AGAIN)
Clear the DTC (see page 05-38 ).
Start the engine.
Run the engine at idle for 15 seconds or more.
Read the DTC.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2120, P2122, P2123, P2125, P2127, P2128 and/or P2138 are output again
A
No DTC output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
A
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
A27
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
Disconnect the A27 sensor connector.
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
VCP2 EPA2
VPA2
VCPA EPA
VPA VCP2
VPA
EPA
VCPA
VPA2
EPA2
VCP2
VPA
E5 VCPA
ECM
VPA2
EPA2
(A27-6)
(A27-5)
(A27-4)
(A27-3)
(A27-2)
(A27-1)
-
Specified Condition
VPA (E5-22)
EPA (E5-28)
VCPA (E5-26)
VPA2 (E5-23)
EPA2 (E5-29)
VCP2 (E5-27)
Below 1 Ω
VPA (A27-6) or VPA (E5-22) - Body ground
EPA (A27-5) or EPA (E5-28) - Body ground
VCPA (A27-4) or VCPA (E5-26) - Body ground
VPA2 (A27-3) or VPA2 (E5-23) - Body ground
EPA2 (A27-2) or EPA2 (E5-29) - Body ground
VCP2 (A27-1) or VCP2 (E5-27) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
EPA
B53781
A67445
A92629
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
453
05-264
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM (VCPA AND VCP2 VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
A27
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
EPA2 (-)
EPA (-)
VCP2 (+)
A19521
A53765
Disconnect the A27 sensor connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VCPA (E5-26) - EPA (E5-28)
VCP2 (E5-27) - EPA2 (E5-29)
4.5 to 5.5 V
E5
ECM
VCPA (+)
A92544
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
OK
3
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY (See page 10-1 1)
GO
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
READ OUTPUT DTC (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR DTCS ARE
OUTPUT AGAIN)
Clear the DTC (see page 05-38 ).
Start the engine.
Run the engine at idle for 15 seconds or more.
Read the DTC.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2120, P2122, P2123, P2125, P2127, P2128 and/or P2138 are output again
A
No DTC output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
A
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
454
05-265
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P2121
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ITH-02
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”D” CIRCUIT
RANGE/PERFORMANCE
HINT:
This is repair procedure for the ”accelerator pedal position sensor”.
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2120 on page 05-257 .
DTC No.
P2121
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Conditions (a) continue for 0.5 seconds:
(a) Difference between VPA and VPA2 exceeds the threshold
(1 trip detection logic)
Open or short in Accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The accelerator pedal position sensor is mounted on the accelerator pedal bracket. The accelerator pedal
position sensor has two sensor elements/signal outputs: VPA and VPA2. VPA is used to detect the actual
accelerator pedal angle (used for engine control) and VPA2 is used to detect malfunctions in VPA. When
the difference between the voltage outputs of VPA and VPA2 deviate from the standard, the ECM concludes
the accelerator pedal position sensor has a malfunction. The ECM turns on the MIL and a DTC is set.
FAIL-SAFE
The accelerator pedal position sensor has 2 (main and sub) sensor circuits. If a malfunction occurs in either
of the sensor circuits, the ECM detects the abnormal signal voltage difference between the 2 sensor circuits
and switches to fail-safe mode. In fail-safe mode, the remaining circuit is used to calculate the accelerator
pedal opening to allow the vehicle to continue driving.
If both circuits malfunction, the ECM regards the opening angle of the accelerator pedal to be fully closed.
In this case, the throttle valve will remain closed as if the engine is idling.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2121: TP sensor malfunction
Required sensors / components (Main)
Accelerator position sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 sec.
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Electronic throttle actuator power
ON
2. Ignition switch
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Learned voltage value of (VTA1 - VTA2)
Less than 0.4 V, or more than 1.2 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
455
05-266
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2120 on page 05-257 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Hand-held tester:
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (ACCEL POS #1, ACCEL POS #2)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Depressed
Released
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ETCS
/ ACCEL POS #1 and ACCEL POS #2” and read its value
displayed on the hand-held tester.
Standard:
Accelerator Pedal
ACCEL POS #1
ACCEL POS #2
Released
0.5 to 1.1 V
1.2 to 2.0 V
Depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
3.4 to 5.3 V
FI7052
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
456
05-267
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
A27
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
Disconnect the A27 sensor connector.
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
VCP2 EPA2
VPA2
VCPA EPA
VPA VCP2
VPA
EPA
VCPA
VPA2
EPA2
VCP2
VPA
E5 VCPA
ECM
(A27-6)
(A27-5)
(A27-4)
(A27-3)
(A27-2)
(A27-1)
-
Specified Condition
VPA (E5-22)
EPA (E5-28)
VCPA (E5-26)
VPA2 (E5-23)
EPA2 (E5-29)
VCP2 (E5-27)
Below 1 Ω
VPA (A27-6) or VPA (E5-22) - Body ground
EPA (A27-5) or EPA (E5-28) - Body ground
VCPA (A27-4) or VCPA (E5-26) - Body ground
VPA2 (A27-3) or VPA2 (E5-23) - Body ground
EPA2 (A27-2) or EPA2 (E5-29) - Body ground
VCP2 (A27-1) or VCP2 (E5-27) - Body ground
VPA2
EPA2
10 kΩ or higher
EPA
B53781
A67445
A92629
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY (See page 10-1 1)
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
INSPECT ECM (VPA AND VPA2 VOLTAGE)
VPA2 (+)
VPA (+)
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage between the specified terminals of
the E5 ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Tester Connection
Accelerator Pedal Position
VPA (E5-22)
- EPA (E5-28)
VPA2 (E5-23)
- EPA2 (E5-29)
Released
0.5 to 1.1 V
1.2 to 2.0 V
Depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
3.4 to 5.3 V
EPA2 (-) E5 EPA (-)
ECM
A53765
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
457
05-268
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
A27
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
Disconnect the A27 sensor connector.
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
VCP2 EPA2
VPA2
VCPA EPA
VPA VCP2
VPA
EPA
VCPA
VPA2
EPA2
VCP2
VPA
E5 VCPA
ECM
VPA2
EPA2
(A27-6)
(A27-5)
(A27-4)
(A17-3)
(A27-2)
(A27-1)
-
Specified Condition
VPA (E5-22)
EPA (E5-28)
VCPA (E5-26)
VPA2 (E5-23)
EPA2 (E5-29)
VCP2 (E5-27)
Below 1 Ω
VPA (A27-6) or VPA (E5-22) - Body ground
EPA (A27-5) or EPA (E5-28) - Body ground
VCPA (A27-4) or VCPA (E5-26) - Body ground
VPA2 (A27-3) or VPA2 (E5-23) - Body ground
EPA2 (A27-2) or EPA2 (E5-29) - Body ground
VCP2 (A27-1) or VCP2 (E5-27) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
EPA
B53781
A67445
A92629
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY (See page 10-1 1)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
458
05-269
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVX-06
DTC
P2195
OXYGEN (A/F) SENSOR SIGNAL STUCK
LEAN (BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2196
OXYGEN (A/F) SENSOR SIGNAL STUCK
RICH (BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
HINT:
Although the title (DTC description) says ”oxygen sensor”, this DTC is related to the ”A/F sensor”.
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Air-Fuel ratio (A/F) sensor provides output voltage* approximately equal to the existing air-fuel ratio.
The A/F sensor output voltage is used to provide feedback for the ECM to control the air-fuel ratio.
With the A/F sensor output, the ECM can determine deviation from the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio and control proper injection time. If the A/F sensor is malfunctioning, the ECM is unable to accurately control air-fuel
ratio.
The A/F sensor is equipped with a heater which heats the zirconia element. The heater is also controlled
by the ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temperature of the exhaust gas is low), current flows
to the heater which heats the sensor to facilitate detection of accurate oxygen concentration.
The A/F sensor is a planar type. Compared to a conventional type, the sensor and heater portions are narrower. Because the heat of the heater is conducted through the alumina to zirconia (of the sensor portion),
sensor activation is accelerated.
To obtain a high purification rate of the CO, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a three-way catalytic converter is used. The converter is most efficient when the air-fuel ratio is maintained near the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio.
HINT:
*: The voltage value changes on the inside of the ECM only.
Alumina
Heater
Platinum
Electrode
Element
Exhaust Gas
A
ECM Monitored
A/F Sensor Voltage
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Cover
A
Atomosphere
Air-Fuel Ratio
A - A Section
A73819
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
459
05-270
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2195
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2 seconds or more:
(a) A/F sensor voltage is more than 3.8 V
(b) Rear oxygen sensor voltage is 0.15 V or more
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and EFI relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
ECM
P2196
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2 seconds or more:
(a) A/F sensor voltage is less than 2.8 V
(b) Rear oxygen sensor voltage is less than 0.85 V
(2 trip detection logic)
Same as DTC No. P2195
HINT:
DTCs P2195 and P2196 indicate a malfunction related to bank 1 of the A/F sensor circuit.
Sensor 1 is the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
After confirming DTC P2195 and P2196, use the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool to confirm
A/F sensor output voltage (AFS B1S1) from the ALL menu (to reach the ALL menu: DIAGNOSIS / EN−
HANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL).
The A/F sensor’s output voltage and the short−term fuel trim value can be read using the OBD II scan
tool or the hand−held tester.
The ECM controls the voltage of the A1A+ and A1A− terminals of the ECM to a fixed voltage. Therefore, it is impossible to confirm the A/F sensor output voltage without the OBD II scan tool or the handheld tester.
The OBD II scan tool (excluding hand−held tester) displays one fifth of the A/F sensor output voltage
which is displayed on the hand−held tester.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Under the air-fuel ratio feedback control, if the voltage output of the A/F sensor indicates RICH or LEAN for
more than a certain period of time, the ECM concludes that there is a fault in the A/F sensor system. The
ECM will turn on the MIL and will set a DTC.
Example:
If the A/F sensor voltage output is less than 2.8 V (very RICH) for 10 seconds even though voltage output
of the heated oxygen sensor output voltage is less than 0.85 V, the ECM sets DTC P2196 or DTC P2198.
If the heated oxygen sensor output voltage is 0.15 V or more but the A/F sensor voltage output is more than
3.8 V (very LEAN) for 10 seconds, DTC P2195 is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2195: A/F Sensor Signal (Bank 1) Stuck Lean
P2196: A/F Sensor Signal (Bank 1) Stuck Rich
Required sensors / components (Main)
A/F sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
Rear HO2S
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 sec.
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
460
05-271
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Time after engine start
30 sec. or more
A/F sensor status
Activated
Fuel system status
Closed Loop
Engine condition
Running
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2195:
Both of the following conditions are met:
-
A/F sensor voltage
More than 3.8 V
Rear HO2S voltage
0.15 V or more
P2196:
Both of the following conditions are met:
-
A/F sensor voltage
Less than 2.8 V
Rear HO2S voltage
Less than 0.85 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
461
05-272
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
A6
A/F Sensor
3
EB1
B-W
B-R
2 +B
4
AF-
B-W
HT 1
Shielded
BR
AF+ 3
2
2
EFI
NO. 2
1
Engine
Room R/B
No. 2
2
13
IK3
HA1A
23
E8
A1A+
31
Y
P-L
5
E8
E8
8
E5
B
A1A-
MREL
Y
3 2D
5
2B
3
1
5
2
EFI
Relay
Engine
Room J/B
EFI
NO. 1
1
4
2I
2F
A
J7
J/C
A BR
W
3
1
E9
E1
A
W-B
F7
FL Block
Assy
A
1
BR
J2
J/C
W
FL
Main
Battery
EH
EE
A90305
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
462
05-273
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
(d)
38 to 75 mph
(60 to 120 km/h)
Idling
Ignition Switch OFF
(c)
2 minutes
(a), (b)
3 to 5 minutes
Time
A79199
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Switch the hand-held tester from normal mode to check mode (see page 05-40 ).
Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessory switched OFF.
Drive the vehicle at 38 to 75 mph (60 to 120 km/h) and engine speed at 1,400 to 3,200 rpm for 3 to
5 minutes.
HINT:
If a malfunction exists, the MIL will be illuminated during step (d).
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of a malfunction will not occur. If you
do not have a hand-held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after performing steps (c) and (d), then
perform steps (c) and (d) again.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
It is possible the malfunctioning area can be found using the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation. The
A/F CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential trouble
areas are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume 12.5 % or increases the injection volume 25 %.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(5) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine idle (press the right or left button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: Less than 0.4 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
463
05-274
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay.
Output voltage of A/F sensor
(sensor 1)
Output voltage of heated oxygen
sensor (sensor 2)
Injection volume
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 1 Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
OK
More than 0.55 V
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 2 Output voltage
A/F sensor
(A/F sensor, heater, A/F sensor circuit)
Output voltage
NG
Injection volume
More than 0.55 V
OK
Less than 0.4V
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 3 Output voltage
Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
OK
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
NG
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 4 Output voltage
Almost
No reaction
OK
Less than 0.4V
+25 %
Less than 3.0V
Output voltage
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Main suspect
trouble area
Output voltage
NG
Almost
No reaction
NG
Heated oxygen sensor
(heated oxygen sensor,
heater, heated oxygen sensor
circuit)
Extremely rich or lean actual
air-fuel ratio
(Injector, fuel pressure, gas
leakage in exhaust system,
etc.)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables a technician to check and graph the voltage outputs of both
the A/F sensor and the heated oxygen sensor.
For displaying the graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2” by pressing ”YES” and push ”ENTER”. Then press ”F4”.
HINT:
If DTC P2195 or P2196 is displayed, check bank 1 sensor 1 circuit.
A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a RICH air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run with a RICH air-fuel mixture.
A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a LEAN air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run with a LEAN air-fuel mixture.
Read freeze frame data using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
464
05-275
DIAGNOSTICS
1
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO A/F SENSOR DTC)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
A/F sensor circuit DTC are output
A
A/F sensor circuit DTC and other codes are output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides A/F sensor DTC are output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-48 )
A
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF A/F SENSOR)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Warm up the A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90
seconds.
Read A/F sensor voltage output on the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Hand-held tester only:
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SNAPSHOT
/ MANUAL SNAPSHOT / USER DATA. Read the values.
Select ”AFS B1S1 / ENGINE SPD” and press YES.
Monitor the A/F sensor voltage carefully.
Check the A/F sensor voltage output under the following conditions:
(1) Allow the engine to idle for 30 seconds.
(2) Run the engine at approximately 2,500 rpm. Do not suddenly change the rpm.
(3) Raise the engine to 4,000 rpm and quickly release the accelerator pedal so that the throttle is
fully closed.
Standard:
Condition (1) and (2)
Voltage change of 3.3 V (0.66 V)* (between approximately 3.1 to 3.5 V) as shown in the illustration.
Condition (3)
A/F sensor voltage increases to 3.8 V (0.76 V)* or more during engine deceleration when fuel
is cut as shown in the illustration.
*: Voltage when using the OBD II scan tool.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
465
05-276
DIAGNOSTICS
Normal Condition
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Malfunction Condition
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(1) Idle
A/F
Sensor
Voltage
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
Engine
RPM
Engine
RPM
”Condition (3)”
3.8 V or More
A/F
Sensor
Voltage
Fuel Cut
Fuel Cut
”Condition (1), (2)”
Change of approximately 3.3 V
When A/F sensor circuit is malfunctioning,
voltage output does not change
A72304
HINT:
Whenever the A/F sensor output voltage remains at approximately 3.3 V (0.660 V)* (see ”Malfunction
Condition” graphic) under any condition as well as the above conditions, the A/F sensor may have an
open circuit. This will happen also when the A/F sensor heater has an open circuit.
Whenever the A/F sensor output voltage remains at a certain value of approximately 3.8 V (0.76 V)*
or more, or 2.8 V (0.56 V)* or less (see ”Malfunction Condition” graphic) under any condition as well
as the above conditions, the A/F sensor may have a short circuit.
The ECM will stop fuel injection (fuel is cut) during engine deceleration. This will cause a LEAN condition and should result in a momentary increase in the A/F sensor output voltage.
The ECM must establish a closed throttle position learned value to perform fuel cut. If the battery terminal has been disconnected, the vehicle must be driven over 10 mph (16 km/h) to allow the ECM to learn
the closed throttle position.
When the vehicle is driven:
The output voltage of the A/F sensor may be below 2.8 V (0.76 V)* during fuel enrichment. For the
vehicle, this translates to a sudden increase in speed with the accelerator pedal fully depressed when
trying to overtake another vehicle. The A/F sensor is functioning normally.
The A/F sensor is a current output element, and therefore the current is converted into voltage inside
the ECM. If measuring voltage at connectors of A/F sensor or ECM, you will observe a constant voltage.
*: Voltage when using the OBD II scan tool.
OK
Go to step 13
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
466
05-277
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
A6
A/F sensor
Disconnect the A6 A/F sensor connector.
Measure the resistance of the A/F sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
20C (68F)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
-
10 kΩ or higher
AF+
AF-
A52607
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
4
INSPECT RELAY (EFI)
1
3
1
5
2
2
5
(a)
(b)
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
467
05-278
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
A6
A/F Sensor
HT
AF+
+B
1
3
2
4
AF-
Check the wire harness between the ECM and A/F sensor.
(1) Disconnect the A6 A/F sensor connector.
(2) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
E8
ECM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A6-3 (AF+) - E8-23 (A1A+)
A6-4 (AF-) - E8-31 (A1A-)
A6-1 (HT) - E8-5 (HA1A)
Below 1 Ω
A6-3 (AF+) or A1A+ (E8-23) - Body ground
A6-4 (AF-) or A1A- (E8-31) - Body ground
A6-1 (HT) or HA1A (E8-5) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A1A+
A1A-
HA1A
A76787
A81695
A86849
Reference
A/F Sensor
EFI Relay
From
Battery
EFI NO. 1
Fuse
ECM
+B Heater HT
EFI NO. 2
Fuse AF- Sensor AF+
HA1A
A1A+
Duty
Control
A1AMREL
A90346
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
468
05-279
DIAGNOSTICS
6
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Check for vacuum leaks in the air induction system.
OK: No leak in the air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
OK
7
(a)
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE (See page 11-4 )
Check fuel pressure (high or low fuel pressure).
Standard:
Item
Specified Condition
Fuel pressure
304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 55 psi)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
OK
8
(a)
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (See page 11-7 )
Check injector injection (high or low fuel injection quantity or poor injection pattern).
Standard:
Injection Volume
Difference Between Each Injector
76 to 91 cm3 (4.6 to 5.5 cu in.)/15 seconds
15 cm3 (0.9 cu in.) or less
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
(See page 11-10 )
OK
9
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
10
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern.
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
469
05-280
DIAGNOSTICS
11
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
READ OUTPUT DTC
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
A/F sensor circuit DTC are not output
A
A/F sensor circuit DTC are output
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 ) AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
A
12
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
OK: Vehicle has run out of fuel in past.
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
YES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
13
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern.
GO
14
(a)
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART (A/F SENSOR DTC OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
A/F sensor circuit DTC are output
A
A/F sensor circuit DTC are not output
B
B
Go to step 18
A
15
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
16
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern.
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
470
05-281
DIAGNOSTICS
17
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
READ OUTPUT DTC (A/F SENSOR DTC OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
A/F sensor circuit DTC are not output
A
A/F sensor circuit DTC are output
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 ) AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
A
18
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
OK: Vehicle has run out of fuel in past.
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
YES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
471
05-282
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EVY-06
DTC
P2238
OXYGEN SENSOR PUMPING CURRENT
CIRCUIT LOW (FOR A/F SENSOR)(BANK 1
SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2239
OXYGEN SENSOR PUMPING CURRENT
CIRCUIT HIGH (FOR A/F SENSOR)(BANK 1
SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2252
OXYGEN SENSOR REFERENCE GROUND
CIRCUIT LOW (FOR A/F SENSOR)(BANK 1
SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2253
OXYGEN SENSOR REFERENCE GROUND
CIRCUIT HIGH (FOR A/F SENSOR)(BANK 1
SENSOR 1)
HINT:
Although the title (DTC description) says ”oxygen sensor”, this DTC is related to the ”A/F sensor”.
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-269 .
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2238
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit low
A/F sensor admittance is less than 0.022 1/Ω
(1 trip detection logic)
HINT:
Main trouble area
Open in A/F sensor circuit
P2238
Condition (a) continues for 5.0 seconds or more :
(a) AF+ is 0.5 V or less
Condition (a) continues for 5.0 seconds or more :
(a) (AF+) - (AF-) is 0.1 V or less
(1 trip detection logic)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and EFI relay circuits
ECM
P2239
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit high
(1 trip detection logic)
HINT:
Main trouble area
Short in A/F sensor circuit
P2239
Condition (a) continues for 5.0 seconds or more :
(a) AF+ is more than 4.5 V
Condition (a) continues for 5.0 seconds or more :
(a) (AF+) - (AF-) is more than 0.8 V
(1 trip detection logic)
Same as DTC No. P2238
P2252
Condition (a) continues for 5.0 seconds or more :
(a) AF- is 0.5 V or less
(1 trip detection logic)
Same as DTC No. P2238
P2253
Condition (a) continues for 5.0 seconds or more :
(a) AF- is more than 4.5 V
(1 trip detection logic)
Same as DTC No. P2238
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
472
05-283
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The air-fuel ratio (A/F) sensor varies its voltage output in proportion to the air-fuel ratio. If impedance (alternating current resistance) or voltage output of the sensor deviates greatly from the standard, the ECM determines that an open or short is in the A/F sensor circuit.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2238: A/F sensor (Bank1) open circuit between AF+ and AFP2238: A/F sensor (Bank1) short circuit between AF+ and AFP2238: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF+ and GND
P2239: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF+ and +B
P2252: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF- and GND
P2253: A/F sensor (Bank 1) short circuit between AF- and +B
Required sensors/ components (Main)
A/F sensor
Required sensors/ components (Related)
ECT sensor, CKP sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 sec.
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
P2238 (open circuit between AF+ and AF-):
Duration while all of the following conditions are met:
20 seconds or more
AF+ terminal voltage
0.5 to 4.5 V
AF- terminal voltage
0.5 to 4.5 V
Difference between AF+ terminal and AF- terminal voltages
0.1 to 0.8 V
ECT
20C (68F) or more
Engine condition
Running
Time after engine start
20 seconds or more
Fuel-cut
OFF
A/F sensor heater duty cycle
0.5% or more
Time after A/F sensor heating
20 seconds or more
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Others:
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
473
05-284
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2238 (Open circuit between AF+ and AF-):
A/F sensor admittance
Below 0.022 1/ohm
P2238 (Short circuit between AF+ and GND):
AF+ terminal voltage
0.5 V or less
P2238 (Short circuit between AF+ and AF-):
Difference between AF+ terminal and AF- terminal voltages
0.1 V or less
P2239 (Short circuit between AF+ and +B):
AF+ terminal voltage
More than 4.5 V
P2252 (Short circuit between AF- and GND):
AF- terminal voltage
0.5 V or less
P2253 (Short circuit between AF- and +B):
AF- terminal voltage
More than 4.5 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-269 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
The malfunctioning area can be found by the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation. The A/F CONTROL
operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other suspected trouble areas are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume by 12.5 % or increases the injection volume by
25 %.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(5) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine idling (press the right or left button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: Less than 0.4 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
474
05-285
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Output voltage of A/F sensor
(sensor 1)
Output voltage of heated oxygen
sensor (sensor 2)
Injection volume
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 1 Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
OK
More than 0.55 V
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 2 Output voltage
A/F sensor
(A/F sensor, heater, A/F sensor circuit)
Output voltage
NG
Injection volume
More than 0.55 V
OK
Less than 0.4V
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 3 Output voltage
Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
OK
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
NG
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 4 Output voltage
Almost
No reaction
OK
Less than 0.4V
+25 %
Less than 3.0V
Output voltage
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Main suspect
trouble area
Output voltage
NG
Almost
No reaction
NG
Heated oxygen sensor
(heated oxygen sensor,
heater, heated oxygen sensor
circuit)
Extremely rich or lean actual
air-fuel ratio
(Injector, fuel pressure, gas
leakage in exhaust system,
etc.)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables a technician to check and graph the voltage outputs of both
the A/F sensor and the heated oxygen sensor.
For displaying the graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2” by pressing ”YES” and push ”ENTER”. Then press ”F4”.
HINT:
If DTC P2237, P2238, P2239, P2251, P2252 or P2253 is displayed, check the bank 1 sensor 1 circuit.
Read freeze frame data using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
475
05-286
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
A6
A/F sensor
Disconnect the A6 A/F sensor connector.
Measure the resistance of the A/F sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
20C (68F)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
-
10 kΩ or higher
AF+
AF-
A52607
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
2
INSPECT RELAY (EFI)
1
3
1
5
2
2
5
(a)
(b)
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
476
05-287
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
A6
A/F Sensor
HT
AF+
+B
1
3
2
4
AF-
Check the wire harness between the ECM and A/F sensor.
(1) Disconnect the A6 A/F sensor connector.
(2) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
E8
ECM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A6-3 (AF+) - E8-23 (A1A+)
A6-4 (AF-) - E8-31 (A1A-)
A6-1 (HT) - E8-5 (HA1A)
Below 1 Ω
A6-3 (AF+) or A1A+ (E8-23) - Body ground
A6-4 (AF-) or A1A- (E8-31) - Body ground
A6-1 (HT) or HA1A (E8-5) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A1A+
A1A-
HA1A
A76787
A81695
A86849
Reference
A/F Sensor
EFI Relay
From
Battery
EFI NO. 1
Fuse
ECM
+B Heater HT
EFI NO. 2
Fuse AF- Sensor AF+
HA1A
A1A+
Duty
Control
A1AMREL
A90346
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
477
05-288
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
05PGP-01
DTC
P2401
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM LEAK
DETECTION PUMP CONTROL CIRCUIT LOW
DTC
P2402
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM LEAK
DETECTION PUMP CONTROL CIRCUIT
HIGH
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to EVAP Inspection Procedure (see page 05-317).
DTCs
P2401
P2402
Monitoring Item
Vacuum pump stuck OFF
(built-in pump module)
Vacuum pump stuck ON
(built-in pump module)
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
To determine leak criterion (Reference
pressure), vacuum pump creates negative
pressure in canister pump module through
0.02 inch orifice and pressure is measured.
Pump module
If one of following conditions is met, ECM
Connector / wire harness
sets pump module related DTCs: P043E,
P043E
(Pump module - ECM)
P043F, P2401, P2402 and P2419:
ECM
Reference pressure is -1 kPa or higher
Reference pressure is -4.85 kPa or lower
Reference pressure is not saturated within
60 seconds
Detection
Timing
Detection
Period
Ignition
OFF
2 trips
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to EVAP Inspection Procedure (see page 05-317).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to EVAP Inspection Procedure (see page 05-317).
Author:
Date:
478
05-289
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the electric vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions
based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35C (95F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned off,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35C (95F) 7 hours after the ignition switch is
turned off, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
-
Operations
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer, 5 hours (7 or 9.5 hours) after ignition switch turned to OFF.
A
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and EVAP system pressure measured by ECM in order to
register atmospheric pressure.
If EVAP pressure is not between 70 kPa and 110 kPa (525 mmHg and 825 mmHg), ECM
cancels EVAP system monitor.
-
10 seconds
B
First 0.02 inch leak
pressure measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through 0.02 inch orifice and them ECM checks if vacuum pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
C
EVAP system pressure measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system, and EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down the measured value as it will be used in the leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not stabilize within 15 minutes, ECM cancels EVAP system monitor.
15 minutes*
D
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then EVAP system pressure measured by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak
pressure measurement
Leak check is performed after second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard is measured.
If stabilized system pressure higher than second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, ECM
determines that EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured and then monitoring result recorded by ECM.
-
* If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement Operation B, E: 0.02 Inch Leak Pressure Measurement
Canister
Fuel Tank
OFF
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
OFF (vent)
Purge VSV: OFF
0.02 Inch Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Vacuum Pump: OFF
Air Filter
ON
Pump Module
Operation D: Purge VSV monitor
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
OFF
ON
ON (closed)
ON (closed)
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
Negative
Pressure
ON
A96746
Author:
Date:
479
05-290
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
In sequence B and E, to determine the leak criterion, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure in the
canister pump module through the 0.02 inch orifice. If the pressure is out of specified range or is not saturated, the ECM illuminates the MIL and sets DTCs P043E, P043F, P2401, P2402 and P2419 (2-trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure during EVAP Monitor
Purge VSV
OFF
OFF
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
Vent Valve
OFF
OFF
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
ON
Vacuum Pump
Malfunction
Malfunction
EVAP Pressure
-1 kPa
Specified
OK
OK
Malfunction
Malfunction
Range
-4.85 kPa
Sequence
Time
A
B
10
sec
60
sec
C
D
E
Within 15 minutes
10
sec
60
sec
A85217
Author:
Date:
480
05-291
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
OBD II MONITOR SPECIFICATIONS
Monitor Strategy
Required Sensors/Components
Purge VSV and pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 15 minutes (varies with amount of fuel in tank)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
Typical Enabling Conditions
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
EVAP key-off monitor runs when all of the following conditions are met:
-
Atomspheric pressure
525 to 825 mmHg (70 to 110 kPa)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
Below 4 km/h (2.5 mph)
Ignition switch
OFF
Engine condition
Not running
Time after engine is stopped
5 hours
FTP sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
Purge VSV
Not operated by scan tool
Vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
Leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before IG switch
OFF:
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle is driven
5 min. or more
2. Purge flow
Executed
ECT
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
IAT
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
Example of re-start time
First time
7 hours
Second time
9 hours and 30 min.
Key-of f monitor sequence: 1 to 8
1. Atmospheric pressure
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
Atmospheric pressure change for 10 sec.
Within 2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) for 1 sec.
2. First reference pressure
Next sequence is run if all of following conditions met
Condition 1, 2 and 3
1. FTP when 4 sec. after reference pressure measurement
-7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa) or less
2. Reference pressure
-36.47 to -7.93 mmHg (-4.85 to -1.057 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
Saturated
3. Vent valve stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP change for 10 sec. after vent valve ON (closed)
2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) or more
4. Vacuum introduction and leak
Next sequence is run if both of following conditions met
Condition 1 and 2
1. Vacuum introduction time
Within 15 min.
2. FTP
FTP was saturated
5. Purge VSV stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP change for 10 sec. after purge VSV ON (open)
2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) or more
Author:
Date:
481
05-292
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
6. Second reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if all of following conditions met
Condition 1, 2, 3 and 4
1. FTP when 4 sec. after reference pressure measurement
-7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa) or less
2. Reference pressure
-36.47 to -7.93 mmHg (-4.85 to -1.057 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
Saturated
4. Reference pressure difference between first and second
Less than 5.25 mmHg (0.7 kPa)
7. Leak check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP when vacuum introduction was complete
Lower than second reference pressure
8. Atmospheric pressure
Monitor is complete if following
-
Atmospheric pressure difference between sequence 1 and 8
Within 2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa)
Typical Malfunction Thresholds
One of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5
1. FTP when 4 seconds after reference pressure measurement began
More than -7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa)
2. Reference pressure
Less than -36.4 mmHg (-4.85 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
-7.9 mmHg (-1.057 kPa) or more
4. Reference pressure
Not saturated
5. Reference pressure difference between first and second
5.2 mmHg (0.7 kPa) or more
MONITOR RESULT (MODE 06)
Refer to page 05-317 for detailed information on Monitor Result.
Author:
Date:
482
05-293
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
-MEMO-
Author:
Date:
483
05-294
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
05IRD-03
DTC
P2419
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
SWITCHING VALVE CONTROL CIRCUIT
LOW
DTC
P2420
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
SWITCHING VALVE CONTROL CIRCUIT
HIGH
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to the EVAP Inspection Procedure (see page 05-317).
DTCs
P2419
P2420
Monitoring Items
Vent valve stuck ON /
Closed (built-in pump module)
Vent valve stuck OFF / Vent
(built-in pump module)
Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
To determine leak criterion (Reference
pressure), vacuum pump creates negative
pressure in canister pump module through
0.02 inch orifice and pressure is measured.
If one of following conditions is met, ECM
sets pump module related DTCs: P043E,
P043F, P2401, P2402 and P2419:
Pump module
Reference pressure is -1 kPa or higher
Connector/Wire harness
Reference pressure is -4.85 kPa or lower
(Pump module - ECM)
Reference pressure is not saturated within
ECM
60 seconds
Detection
Timings
Detection
Logic
Ignition
OFF
2 trips
To determine leak criterion, vacuum pump
creates negative pressure in canister pump
module through 0.02 inch orifice. After that,
ECM turns vent valve ON (Vent) and measures pressure. If it does not change, ECM
sets DTC P2420.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to the EVAP Inspection Procedure (see page 05-317).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP Inspection Procedure (see page 05-317).
Author:
Date:
484
05-295
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours* after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the electric vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions
based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35C (95F) 5 hours after the ignition switch is turned off,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35C (95F) 7 hours after the ignition switch is
turned off, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
-
Operations
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer, 5 hours (7 or 9.5 hours) after ignition switch turned to OFF.
A
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and EVAP system pressure measured by ECM in order to
register atmospheric pressure.
If EVAP pressure is not between 70 kPa and 110 kPa (525 mmHg and 825 mmHg), ECM
cancels EVAP system monitor.
-
10 seconds
B
First 0.02 inch leak
pressure measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, vacuum pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through 0.02 inch orifice and them ECM checks if vacuum pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
C
EVAP system pressure measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system, and EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down the measured value as it will be used in the leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not stabilize within 15 minutes, ECM cancels EVAP system monitor.
15 minutes*
D
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then EVAP system pressure measured by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak
pressure measurement
Leak check is performed after second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard is measured.
If stabilized system pressure higher than second 0.02 inch leak pressure standard, ECM
determines that EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
F
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured and then monitoring result recorded by ECM.
-
* If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement Operation B, E: 0.02 Inch Leak Pressure Measurement
Canister
Fuel Tank
OFF
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
OFF (vent)
Purge VSV: OFF
0.02 Inch Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Vacuum Pump: OFF
Air Filter
ON
Pump Module
Operation D: Purge VSV monitor
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
OFF
ON
ON (closed)
ON (closed)
Atmospheric
Pressure
ON
Negative
Pressure
ON
A96746
Author:
Date:
485
05-296
DIAGNOSTICS
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
P2419: Vent valve stuck ON (Closed)
In sequence B and E, to determine the leak criterion, the vacuum pump creates negative pressure in
the canister pump module through the 0.02 inch orifice. If the pressure is out of specified range or is
not saturated, the ECM illuminates the MIL and sets DTCs P043E, P043F, P2401, P2402 and P2419
(2-trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure during EVAP Monitor
Purge VSV
OFF
OFF
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
Vent Valve
OFF
OFF
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
ON
Vacuum Pump
Malfunction
Malfunction
EVAP Pressure
-1 kPa
Specified
OK
OK
Malfunction
Malfunction
Range
-4.85 kPa
Sequence
Time
A
B
C
D
E
10
sec
60
sec
Within 15 minutes
10
sec
60
sec
A85217
Author:
Date:
486
05-297
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
P2420: Vent valve stuck OFF (Vent)
After sequence B, the ECM changes the vent valve from OFF (Vent) to ON (Closed) and measures
the EVAP pressure. If the pressure does not change, the ECM illuminates the MIL and sets DTC P2420
(2-trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when Vent Valve Stuck OFF (vent):
Purge VSV
OFF
Vent Valve
Vacuum Pump
OFF
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
ON
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
OK
First 0.02 inch
Leak Pressure
Standard
Malfunction
Sequence
Time
A
B
10
sec
60
sec
C
D
E
Within 15 minutes
10
60
sec
G36780
Author:
Date:
487
05-298
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
OBD II MONITOR SPECIFICATIONS
Monitor Strategy
Required Sensors/Components
Purge VSV and pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 15 minutes (varies with amount of fuel in tank)
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
Typical Enabling Conditions
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
EVAP key-off monitor runs when all of the following conditions met:
-
Atmospheric pressure
525 to 825 mmHg (70 to 110 kPa)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
Below 4 km/h (2.5 mph)
Ignition switch
OFF
Engine condition
Not running
Time after engine stopped
5 hours
FTP sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
Purge VSV
Not operated by scan tool
Vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
Leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions are met before IG switch
OFF:
Condition 1 and 2
1. Duration that vehicle is driven
5 min. or more
2. Purge flow
Executed
ECT
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
IAT
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
Accumulated purge volume
100 g or more (varies with engine coolant temperature)
Example of re-start time
First time
7 hours
Second time
9 hours and 30 min.
Key-of f monitor sequence: 1 to 8
1. Atmospheric pressure
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
Atmospheric pressure change for 10 sec.
Within 2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) for 1 sec.
2. First reference pressure
Next sequence is run if all of following conditions met
Condition 1, 2 and 3
1. FTP when 4 sec. after reference pressure measurement
-7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa) or less
2. Reference pressure
-36.47 to -7.93 mmHg (-4.85 to -1.057 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
Saturated
3. Vent valve stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP change for 10 sec. after vent valve ON (closed)
2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) or more
4. Vacuum introduction and leak
Next sequence is run if both of following conditions met
Condition 1 and 2
1. Vacuum introduction time
Within 15 min.
2. FTP
FTP was saturated
5. Purge VSV stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP change for 10 sec. after purge VSV ON (open)
2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa) or more
Author:
Date:
488
05-299
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
6. Second reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if all of following conditions met
Condition 1, 2, 3 and 4
1. FTP when 4 sec. after reference pressure measurement
-7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa) or less
2. Reference pressure
-36.47 to -7.93 mmHg (-4.85 to -1.057 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
Saturated
4. Reference pressure difference between first and second
Less than 5.25 mmHg (0.7 kPa)
7. Leak check
Next sequence is run if following condition met
-
FTP when vacuum introduction was complete
Lower than second reference pressure
8. Atmospheric pressure
Monitor is complete if following
-
Atmospheric pressure difference between sequence 1 and 8
Within 2.25 mmHg (0.3 kPa)
Typical Malfunction Thresholds
P2419: Vent valve stuck open
Following values are when atmospheric pressure is 760
mmHg (100 kPa)
-
One of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5
1. FTP when 4 seconds after reference pressure measurement began
More than -7.5 mmHg (-1 kPa)
2. Reference pressure
Less than -36.4 mmHg (-4.85 kPa)
3. Reference pressure
-7.9 mmHg (-1.057 kPa) or more
4. Reference pressure
Not saturated
5. Reference pressure difference between first and second
5.2 mmHg (0.7 kPa) or more
P2420: Vent valve stuck closed
FTP change for 10 sec. after vent valve opened
Less than 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
MONITOR RESULT (MODE 06)
Refer to page 05-317 for detailed information on Monitor Result.
Author:
Date:
489
05-300
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P2610
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05IRF-02
ECM/PCM INTERNAL ENGINE OFF TIMER
PERFORMANCE
DTC SUMMARY
DTC
P2610
Monitoring Items
Malfunction Detection Conditions
Soak timer (built into ECM)
ECM internal malfunction
Trouble Areas
ECM
Detection
Timings
Detection
Logic
Engine
running
2 trip
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
To ensure the accuracy of the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) monitor values, the soak timer, which is built
into the ECM, measures 5 hours (15 minutes) from when the ignition switch is turned OFF, before the monitor is run. This allows the fuel to cool down, which stabilizes the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP). When 5 hours
have elapsed, the ECM turns on.
Soak Timer Circuit
Ignition Switch
ECM
IGSW
15 A
EFI MAIN
+B
MREL
Battery
Power
Source IC
Main Relay
Control IC
Soak Timer IC
A85251
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the soak timer activates the ECM to begin the EVAP system
monitor. While the engine is running, the ECM monitors the synchronization of the soak timer and the CPU
clock. If these two are not synchronized, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction, illuminates the MIL and
sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
490
05-301
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
OBD II MONITOR SPECIFICATIONS
Monitor Strategy
Required Sensors/Components
ECM
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 minutes
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
Typical Enabling Conditions
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-16
Ignition switch
ON
Engine
Running
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Starter
OFF
Typical Malfunction Thresholds
Soak timer measurement when ECM CPU clock counts 10
minutes
Less than 7 minutes, or more than 13 minutes
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
DTC P2610 is set if an internal ECM problem is detected. Diagnostic procedures are not required. ECM
replacement is required.
Read freeze frame data using a hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data record the
engine condition when malfunctions are detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help
determine if the vehicle was moving or stationary, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data, from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
REPLACE ECM (see page 10-9 )
NEXT
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect a hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch to ON.
Clear DTCs (see page 05-38 ).
Start the engine and wait for 10 minutes or more.
On the tester, select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
If no pending DTC is displayed, the repair has been successfully completed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
491
05-302
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P2A00
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05EW5-06
A/F SENSOR CIRCUIT SLOW RESPONSE
(BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-269 .
DTC No.
P2A00
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
In conditions (a), (b) and (c), when A/F sensor output voltage
change value is below regular value against fuel trim change
value, ECM judges that A/F sensor circuit has slow response:
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Engine is warmed up
(b) Engine speed 1,400 rpm or more
(c) Vehicle speed 60 to 120 km/h (37 to 74 mph)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
Open or short in A/F sensor and EFI relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
PCV hose connection
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Locus Length
A/F Output (V)
Fuel Trim
Fast Sensor
Slow Sensor
A82390
The Air-Fuel ratio (A/F) sensor varies its output voltage in proportion to the air-fuel ratio. Based on the output
voltage, the ECM determines if the air-fuel ratio is RICH or LEAN and adjusts the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio.
The ECM also checks the fuel injection volume compensation value to check if the A/F sensor is deteriorating
or not. A/F sensor response deterioration is determined by the ratio of the A/F sensor output voltage variation
and fuel trim variation.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
492
05-303
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2A00: A/F sensor slow response
Required sensors / components (Main)
A/F sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
Vehicle speed sensor (VSS) and crankshaft position (CKP) sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
60 sec.
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-16
Engine condition
Running
Time after engine start
120 sec. or more
Fuel system status
Closed Loop
A/F sensor status
Activated
Idle
OFF
Time after idle OFF
2 sec. or more
Engine RPM
1,400 to 3,200 rpm
Vehicle speed
60 to 120 km/h (37.5 to 75 mph)
Fuel cut
OFF
Time after fuel cut is OFF
2 sec. or more
Driving for 20 sec. or more
40 km/h (25 mph) or more and 900 rpm or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Response rate deterioration level
8 or more
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-24 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-26 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $06: A/F sensor
TLT
0
CID
$01
Unit Conversion
Multiply by 0.000244
(no dimension)
Description of Test Data
Description of Test Limit
Parameter for identify A/F sensor response
rate
Malfunction threshold for A/F sensor deterioration
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-269 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
The malfunctioning area can be found by the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation. The A/F CONTROL
operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other suspected trouble areas are malfunctioning or not.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
493
05-304
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume by 12.5% or increases the injection volume by
25%.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(5) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine idling (press the right or left button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: Less than 0.4 V
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Output voltage of A/F sensor
(sensor 1)
Output voltage of heated oxygen
sensor (sensor 2)
Injection volume
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 1 Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
OK
More than 0.55 V
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 2 Output voltage
A/F sensor
(A/F sensor, heater, A/F sensor circuit)
Output voltage
NG
Injection volume
More than 0.55 V
OK
Less than 0.4V
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 3 Output voltage
Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
OK
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
NG
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 4 Output voltage
Almost
No reaction
OK
Less than 0.4V
+25 %
Less than 3.0V
Output voltage
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Main suspect
trouble area
Output voltage
NG
Almost
No reaction
NG
Heated oxygen sensor
(heated oxygen sensor,
heater, heated oxygen sensor
circuit)
Extremely rich or lean actual
air-fuel ratio
(Injector, fuel pressure, gas
leakage in exhaust system,
etc.)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables a technician to check and graph the voltage outputs of both
the A/F sensor and the heated oxygen sensor.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
494
05-305
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
For displaying the graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2” by pressing ”YES” and push ”ENTER”. Then press ”F4”.
HINT:
DTC P2A00 may be also detected, when the air fuel ratio is stuck rich or lean.
A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a RICH air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run with a RICH air-fuel mixture.
A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a LEAN air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run with a LEAN air-fuel mixture.
Read freeze frame data using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO A/F SENSOR DTC)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
Only P2A00 is output
A
P2A00 and other codes is output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P2A00 is output, perform the troubleshoot on that DTC before.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-48 )
A
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
READ VALUE OF OBD II SCAN TOOL OR HAND-HELD TESTER (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF A/F SENSOR)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Warm up the A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90
seconds.
Read the A/F sensor voltage output on the the hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool.
Hand-held tester only:
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SNAPSHOT
/ MANUAL SNAPSHOT / USER DATA. Read the values.
Select ”AFS B1 S1 / ENGINE SPD” and press YES.
Monitor the A/F sensor voltage carefully.
Check the A/F sensor voltage output under the following conditions:
(1) Allow the engine to idle for 30 seconds.
(2) Run the engine at approximately 2,500 rpm. Do not suddenly change the rpm.
(3) Raise the engine speed to 4,000 rpm and quickly release the accelerator pedal so that the throttle
is fully closed.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
495
05-306
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Standard:
Condition (1) and (2)
Voltage change of 3.3 V (0.66 V)* (between approximately 3.1 to 3.5 V) as shown in the illustration.
Condition (3)
A/F sensor voltage increases to 3.8 V (0.76 V)* or more when fuel is cut during engine deceleration as shown in the illustration.
*: Voltage when using the OBD II scan tool.
Normal Condition
Malfunction Condition
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(1) Idle
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
A/F
Sensor
Voltage
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
Engine
RPM
Engine
RPM
”Condition (3)”
3.8 V or More
A/F
Sensor
Voltage
Fuel Cut
Fuel Cut
When A/F sensor circuit is malfunctioning,
voltage output does not change
”Condition (1), (2)”
Change of approximately 3.3 V
A72304
HINT:
Whenever the A/F sensor output voltage remains at approximately 3.3 V (0.660 V)* (see ”Malfunction
Condition” graphic) under any condition as well as the above conditions, the A/F sensor may have an
open circuit. This will happen also when the A/F sensor heater has an open circuit.
Whenever the A/F sensor output voltage remains at a certain value of approximately 3.8 V (0.76 V)*
or more, or 2.8 V (0.56 V)* or less (see ”Malfunction Condition” graphic) under any condition as well
as the above conditions, the A/F sensor may have a short circuit.
The ECM will stop fuel injection (fuel is cut) during engine deceleration. This will cause a LEAN condition and should result in a momentary increase in the A/F sensor output voltage.
The ECM must establish a closed throttle position learned value to perform fuel cut. If the battery terminal has been disconnected, the vehicle must be driven over 10 mph (16 km/h) to allow the ECM to learn
the closed throttle position.
When the vehicle is driven:
The output voltage of the A/F sensor may be below 2.8 V (0.76 V)* during fuel enrichment. For the
vehicle, this translates to a sudden increase in speed with the accelerator pedal fully depressed when
trying to overtake another vehicle. The A/F sensor is functioning normally.
The A/F sensor is a current output element, and therefore the current is converted into voltage inside
the ECM. If measuring voltage at connectors of the A/F sensor or ECM, you will observe a constant
voltage.
*: Voltage when using the OBD II scan tool.
OK
Go to step 14
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
496
05-307
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
NG
3
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
A6
A/F sensor
Disconnect the A6 A/F sensor connector.
Measure the resistance of the A/F sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
20C (68F)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
-
10 kΩ or higher
AF+
AF-
A52607
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
4
INSPECT RELAY (EFI)
1
3
1
5
2
2
5
(a)
(b)
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
497
05-308
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
A6
A/F Sensor
HT
AF+
+B
1
3
2
4
AF-
Check the wire harness between the ECM and A/F sensor.
(1) Disconnect the A6 A/F sensor connector.
(2) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
E8
ECM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A6-3 (AF+) - E8-23 (A1A+)
A6-4 (AF-) - E8-31 (A1A-)
A6-1 (HT) - E8-5 (HA1A)
Below 1 Ω
A6-3 (AF+) or A1A+ (E8-23) - Body ground
A6-4 (AF-) or A1A- (E8-31) - Body ground
A6-1 (HT) or HA1A (E8-5) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A1A+
A1A-
HA1A
A76787
A81695
A86849
Reference
A/F Sensor
EFI Relay
From
Battery
EFI NO. 1
Fuse
ECM
+B Heater HT
EFI NO. 2
Fuse AF- Sensor AF+
HA1A
A1A+
Duty
Control
A1AMREL
A90346
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
6
(a)
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Check for vacuum leaks in the air induction system.
OK: There is no leak in the air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
498
05-309
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK CONNECTION OF PCV HOSE
OK: PCV hose is connected correctly and PCV hose has no damage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
8
(a)
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE (See page 11-4 )
Check fuel pressure (high or low fuel pressure).
Standard:
Item
Specified Condition
Fuel pressure
304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 55 psi)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
OK
9
(a)
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (See page 11-7 )
Check injector injection (high or low fuel injection quantity or poor injection pattern).
Standard:
Injection Volume
Difference Between Each Injector
76 to 91 cm3 (4.6 to 5.5cu in.) / 15 seconds
15 cm3 (0.9 cu in.) or less
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
(See page 11-10 )
OK
10
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
11
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (See page 05-269 )
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern (see page 05-269 ).
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
499
05-310
DIAGNOSTICS
12
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
READ OUTPUT DTC (A/F SENSOR DTC OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
DTC P2A00 is not output
A
DTC P2A00 is output
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 ) AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(See page 05-269 )
A
13
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
YES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
14
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (See page 05-269 )
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern (see page 05-269 ).
GO
15
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (A/F SENSOR DTC OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
DTC P2A00 is output
A
DTC P2A00 is not output
B
B
Go to step 19
A
16
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
500
05-31 1
DIAGNOSTICS
17
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (See page 05-269 )
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern (see page 05-269 ).
GO
18
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (A/F SENSOR DTC OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
DTC P2A00 is not output
A
DTC P2A00 is output
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-9 ) AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (See page
05-269 )
A
19
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
OK: Vehicle has run out of fuel in past.
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-9 )
YES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
501
05-26
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ITC-02
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
1.
PURPOSE OF THE READINESS TESTS
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD II) system is designed to monitor the performance of emission-related components, and report any detected abnormalities with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
Since various components need to be monitored during different driving conditions, the OBD II system
runs separate monitoring programs called readiness monitors.
The hand-held tester’s software must be version 9.0 or newer to view the readiness monitor status.
From the ”ENHANCED OBD II” menu, select ”MONITOR STATUS” to view the readiness monitor status.
A generic OBD II scan tool can also be used to view the readiness monitor status.
When the readiness monitor status reads ”complete”, the necessary conditions have been met for running performance tests for that readiness monitor.
HINT:
Many state Inspection and Maintenance (I/M) programs require a vehicle’s readiness monitor status to show
”complete”.
The readiness monitor will be reset to ”incomplete” if:
The ECM has lost battery power or blown a fuse.
DTCs have been cleared.
The conditions for running the readiness monitor have not been met.
If the readiness monitor status shows ”incomplete”, follow the appropriate readiness monitor drive pattern to change the status to ”complete”.
CAUTION:
Strictly observe posted speed limits, traffic laws, and road conditions when performing these drive
patterns.
NOTICE:
The following drive patterns are the fastest method of completing all the requirements necessary for
making the readiness monitor status read ”complete”.
If forced to momentarily stop a drive pattern due to traffic or other factors, the drive pattern can be
resumed. Upon completion of the drive pattern, in most cases, the readiness monitor status will
change to ”complete”.
Sudden changes in vehicle load and speed, such as driving up and down hills and/or sudden acceleration, hinder readiness monitor completion.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
216
05-27
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CATALYST MONITOR (A/F SENSOR TYPE)
64 to 88 km/h
(40 to 55 mph)
64 to 80 km/h
(40 to 50 mph)
Idling
Ignition Switch OFF
Warm up time
(idle speed)
4 minutes
16 minutes
A82401
(a)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
The MIL is OFF.
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is 75°C (167°F) or higher.
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) is -10°C (14°F) or higher.*
NOTICE:
* 2002 and later MY vehicles:
To complete the readiness test in cold ambient conditions (less than -10°C/14°F), turn the ignition
switch OFF and then back to ON. Perform the drive pattern a second time.
(b) Drive Pattern
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3 to check readiness monitor status and preconditions
(refer to step (a)).
(2) Drive the vehicle at 40 to 55 mph (64 to 88 km/h) for approximately 4 minutes.
NOTICE:
Drive with smooth throttle operation and avoid sudden acceleration.
If IAT was less than 10°C (50°F) when the engine was started, drive the vehicle at 40 to 55 mph (64
to 88 km/h) for an additional 4 minutes.
(3) Drive the vehicle allowing speed to fluctuate between 40 to 50 mph (64 to 80 km/h) for about 16
minutes.
NOTICE:
Drive with smooth throttle operation and avoid sudden closure of the throttle.
(4) Check the status of the readiness monitor on the scan tool display. If the readiness monitor status
did not switch to complete, ensure preconditions are met, turn the ignition OFF, and then repeat
steps (2) and (3).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
217
05-28
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
3.
(a)
EVAP MONITOR (KEY-OFF MONITOR)
Preconditions
The monitor will run when all of the following conditions are met:
The fuel level is less than 90 %.
The altitude is less than 8,000 ft. (2,450 m).
The vehicle is stopped.
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is between 4.4 and 35°C (40 to 95°F).
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) is between 4.4 and 35°C (40 to 95 °F).
(b) Monitor condition
(1) Allow the engine to idle for 300 seconds or more.
(2) Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for 6 hours.
(3) Connect the scan tool to the DLC3 to check the monitor status and the preconditions.
(4) Check the readiness monitor status.
If ”INCMP” is displayed , the monitor is not completed. Turn the ignition switch OFF, confirm the preconditions
and perform the monitor condition again.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
218
05-29
DIAGNOSTICS
4.
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
OXYGEN / AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR MONITOR (FRONT A/F SENSOR AND REAR O2S SYSTEM)
112 km/h (70 mph)
(under 3200 rpm)
64 km/h (40 mph)
(over 1400 rpm)
Once
Twice
10 times
40 km/h (25 mph)
(over 900 rpm)
Idling
Ignition Switch OFF
Over
Over
Over
Over
2 minutes 150 seconds
40 seconds 40 seconds
Over
Over
Over
10 seconds
10 seconds 10 seconds
(a)
(b)
Over
40 seconds
A82400
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
The MIL is OFF.
Drive Pattern
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions (refer to
step (a)).
(2) Start the engine and allow it to idle for 2 minutes or more.
(3) Drive the vehicle at 64 to 112 km/h (40 to 70 mph) for at least 150 seconds.
(4) Stop the vehicle and allow the engine to idle for 10 seconds or more.
(5) Drive the vehicle at 40 to 64 km/h (25 to 40 mph) for at least 40 seconds.
(6) Stop the vehicle and allow the engine to idle for 10 seconds or more.
(7) Perform steps (5) and (6) ten times.
(8) Check the readiness monitor status. If the readiness monitor status did not change to ”complete”,
check the preconditions, turn the ignition switch OFF, and repeat steps (1) to (6).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
219
05-30
DIAGNOSTICS
5.
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
OXYGEN / A/F SENSOR HEATER MONITOR
40 km/h
(25 mph)
Idling
Ignition Switch OFF
Over 500 seconds
Over 2 minutes
A78886
(a)
(b)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
The MIL is OFF.
Drive Pattern
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions (refer to
step (a)).
(2) Start the engine and allow it to idle for 500 seconds or more.
(3) Drive the vehicle at 40 km/h (25 mph) or more for at least 2 minutes.
(4) Check the readiness monitor status. If the readiness monitor status did not change to ”complete”,
check preconditions, turn the ignition switch OFF, and repeat steps (2) and (3).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
220
05-12
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05MOI-01
REGISTRATION
NOTICE:
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) must be input into the replaced ECM.
HINT:
The VIN is a 17-digit alphanumeric vehicle identification number. A hand-held tester is required to register
the VIN.
1.
DESCRIPTION
This registration section consists of three parts, Input Instructions, Read VIN and Write VIN.
(a) Input Instructions: Explains the general VIN input instructions using a hand-held tester.
(b) Read VIN: Explains the VIN reading process in a flowchart. This process allows the VIN stored in the
ECM to be read, in order to confirm that the two VINs, provided with the vehicle and stored in the vehicle’s ECM, are the same.
(c) Write VIN: Explains the VIN writing process in a flowchart. This process allows the VIN to be input into
the ECM. If the ECM is changed, or the VINs do not match, the VIN can be registered, or overwritten
in the ECM by following this procedure.
2.
INPUT INSTRUCTIONS
(a) Hand-held tester
(1) The arrow buttons (UP, DOWN, RIGHT and LEFT) and numerical buttons (0 to 9) are used, in
order to input the VIN.
(b) Cursor Operation
(1) To move the cursor around the tester screen, press the RIGHT and LEFT buttons.
(c) Alphabetical Character Input
(1) Press the UP and DOWN buttons to select the desired alphabetical character.
(2) After selection, the cursor should move.
(d) Numeric Character Input
(1) Press the numerical button corresponding to the number that you want to input.
(2) After input, the cursor should move.
HINT:
Numerical characters can be selected by using the UP and DOWN buttons.
(e) Correction
(1) When correcting the input character(s), put the cursor onto the character using the RIGHT or
LEFT button.
(2) Select or input the correct character using the UP/DOWN buttons, or the numerical buttons.
(f)
Finishing Input Operation
(1) Make sure that the input VIN matches the vehicle VIN after input.
(2) Press the ENTER button on the tester.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
202
05-13
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
READ VIN (Vehicle Identification Number)
Read VIN using a hand-held tester.
READ:
START
Confirm vehicle VIN
Preparation:
1. Connect hand-held tester to DLC3
2. Turn ignition switch to ON
3. Turn tester ON
Hand-held tester operation:
1. Select DIAGNOSIS
2. Select ENHANCED OBD ll
3. Select VIN
Menu Screen:
VIN
Select VIN READ
1. VIN READ
2. VIN WRITE
DTC P0630 Set
ERROR
DTC P0630 was detected.
P0630 [VIN Not Programmed
or Mismatch - ECM/PCM]
ERROR
*********************************
[
VIN
]
*********************************
[EXIT]
ECM does not respond the VIN.
17-digit VIN
displayed
Please input the VIN.
PRESS [EXIT]
VIN Not Stored
VIN Previously Stored
PRESS [EXIT]
Possible cause:
1: VIN is not written yet.
2: Vehicle does not support this
function.
PRESS [EXIT]
[EXIT]
[EXIT]
To Menu Screen
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
203
05-14
DIAGNOSTICS
4.
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
WRITE VIN
Write VIN using the hand-held tester.
Write:
START
Confirm vehicle VIN
Preparation:
1. Connect hand-held tester to DLC3
2. Turn ignition switch to ON
3. Turn tester ON
Hand-held tester operation:
1. Select DIAGNOSIS
2. Select ENHANCED OBD ll
3. Select VIN
Menu Screen:
VIN
Select VIN WRITE
1. VIN READ
1.
READ
2. VIN WRITE
CONFIRMATION
This function will erase the
DTCs automatically after
writing the VIN.
VIN Previously Stored
NOTICE
This function overwrites the
following VIN with a new VIN.
*********************************
Do you wish to continue?
[
VIN
]
*********************************
[YES] or [NO]
Do you wish to continue?
[NO]
[YES]
[YES] to Continue
[NO] to EXIT
[YES]
17-digit VIN displayed
To Menu
Screen
Continued on next page
[YES]
[NO]
To Menu Screen
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
204
05-15
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Continued from previous page
New Registration
SET NEW VIN
VIN input method
CONFIRMATION
Vehicle is stopped.
Engine is not running.
Input Instructions
[ENTER]
Press [RIGHT]/[LEFT] to shift
the cursor right/left.
Press [UP]/[DOWN] to
increase/decrease value.
Or, input digit with the 10 key.
PRESS [ENTER]
PRESS [ENTER]
[ENTER]
Input a new VIN
If you want to clear the VIN,
press [NO] key.
PRESS [ENTER]
[ENTER]
Input Error
INPUT ERROR
Your VIN is incorrect.
Please enter the VIN again.
NOW WRITING
[EXIT]
[EXIT] to RETURN
Writing Succeeded
WRITING COMPLETE
Writing Error
Communication Error
WRITING FAILED
COMMUNICATION ERROR
Turn IG OFF, then ON.
Please try again.
Turn IG OFF, then ON.
PRESS [EXIT]
PRESS [EXIT]
[EXIT]
[EXIT]
The following VIN has been
written correctly.
The DTCs have been erased
correctly.
PRESS [ENTER]
[ENTER]
To Menu Screen
To Menu Screen
To Menu Screen
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
205
05-2
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
05ESJ-05
PART AND SYSTEM NAME LIST
This reference list indicates the part names used in this manual along with their definitions.
TOYOTA/LEXUS name
Definition
Toyota HCAC system, Hydro-carbon Adsorptive Catalyst
(HCAC) system, HC adsorptive three-way catalyst
HC adsorptive three-way catalytic converter
Variable valve timing sensor, VVT sensor
Camshaft position sensor
Variable valve timing system, VVT system
Camshaft timing control system
Camshaft timing oil control valve, Oil control valve, OCV,
VVT, VSV
Camshaft timing oil control valve
Variable timing and lift, VVTL
Camshaft timing and lift control
Crankshaft position sensor ”A”
Crankshaft position sensor
Engine speed sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
THA
Intake air temperature
Knock control module
Engine knock control module
Knock sensor
Engine knock sensor
Mass or volume air flow circuit
Mass air flow meter circuit
Vacuum sensor
Manifold air pressure sensor
Internal control module, Control module, Engine control
ECU, PCM
Power train control module
FC idle
Deceleration fuel cut
Idle air control valve
Idle speed control
CCV, Canister close valve VSV for canister control
Evaporative emissions canister vent valve
EVAP VSV, Vacuum switching valve assembly No. 1, EVAP
VSV, Purge VSV
Evaporative emissions canister purge valve
VSV for pressure switching valve, Bypass VSV
Evaporative emission pressure switching valve
Vapor pressure sensor, EVAP pressure sensor, Evaporative
emission control system pressure sensor
Fuel tank pressure sensor
Charcoal canister
Evaporative emissions canister
ORVR system
On-board refueling vapor recovery system
Intake manifold runner control
Intake manifold tuning system
Intake manifold runner valve, IMRV, IACV (runner valve)
Intake manifold tuning valve
Intake control VSV
Intake manifold tuning solenoid valve
AFS
Air fuel ratio sensor
O2 sensor
Heater oxygen sensor
Oxygen sensor pumping current circuit
Oxygen sensor output signal
Oxygen sensor reference ground circuit
Oxygen sensor signal ground
Accel position sensor
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Throttle actuator control motor, Actuator control motor, Electronic throttle motor, Throttle control motor
Electronic throttle actuator
Electronic throttle control system, Throttle actuator control
system
Electronic throttle control system
Throttle/pedal position sensor, Throttle/pedal position switch,
Throttle position sensor/switch
Throttle position sensor
Turbo press sensor
Turbocharger pressure sensor
Turbo VSV
Turbocharger pressure control solenoid valve
P/S pressure switch
Power-steering pressure switch
VSV for ACM
Active control engine mount
Speed sensor, Vehicle speed sensor ”A”, Speed sensor for
skid control ECU
Vehicle speed sensor
ATF temperature sensor, Trans. fluid temp. sensor, ATF
temperature sensor ”A”
Transmission fluid temperature sensor
Electronic controlled automatic transmission, ECT
Electronically controlled automatic
Intermediate shaft speed sensor ”A”
Counter gear speed sensor
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
192
05-3
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
TOYOTA/LEXUS name
Definition
Output speed sensor
Output shaft speed sensor
Input speed sensor, Input turbine speed sensor ”A”, Speed
sensor (NT), Turbine speed sensor
Input turbine speed sensor
PNP switch, NSW
Park/neutral position switch
Pressure control solenoid
Transmission pressure control solenoid
Shift solenoid
Transmission shift solenoid valve
Transmission control switch, Shift lock control unit
Shift lock control module
Engine immobilizer system, Immobilizer system
Vehicle anti-theft system
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
193
05-8
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
051ZG-11
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
Inspector’s
Name
SFI SYSTEM Check Sheet
VIN
Date Vehicle
Brought in
Production Date
Licence Plate No.
Odometer Reading
Problem Symptoms
Customer’s Name
Engine Does
Not Start
Engine does not crank
Difficult to
Start
Engine cranks slowly
Other
Poor Idling
Incorrect first idle
Idling rpm is abnormal
Rough idling
Other
Poor
Driveability
Hesitation
Knocking
Engine Stall
Soon after starting
After accelerator pedal depressed
After accelerator pedal released
During A/C operation
Shifting from N to D
Other
km
miles
No initial combustion
Backfire
Other
No complete combustion
High (
rpm)
Low (
Muffler explosion (after-fire)
rpm)
Surging
Other
Date Problem
Occurred
Condition When
Problem Occurs
Problem Frequency
Constant
Other
Sometimes (
times per
Weather
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Outdoor
Temperature
Hot
Warm
Cool
Place
Highway
Rough road
Engine Temp.
Cold
Engine Operation
Just after starting (
Starting
Driving
Constant speed
A/C switch ON/OFF
Other
Suburbs
Other
Warming up
Condition of Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL)
Normal Mode
(Pre-check)
day/month)
Snowy
Various/Other
C/
Cold (approx.
Inner City
After Warming up
Once only
Uphill
Any temp.
min.)
Idling
Acceleration
F)
Downhill
Other
Racing
Deceleration
Remains on
Sometimes lights up
Does not light up
Normal
Malfunction code(s) (code
Freeze frame data (
)
Malfunction code(s) (code
Freeze frame data (
)
)
DTC Inspection
Check Mode
Normal
)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
198
05-48
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
051ZH-16
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
Parameters listed in the chart may be different than your readings depending on the type of instrument used
and other factors.
During the DTC check, refer to the table below if a malfunction code is displayed. For details about each
code, refer to the page number in the DTC chart’s left column.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
P0010
(05-55 )
Camshaft Position ”A” Actuator
Circuit (Bank 1)
Open or short in OCV circuit
OCV valve
ECM
P0011
(05-61 )
Camshaft Position ”A” -Timing
Over - Advanced or System Performance (Bank 1)
Valve timing
OCV
VVT controller assembly
ECM
P0012
(05-61 )
Camshaft Position ”A” -Timing
Over- Retarded (Bank 1)
Same as DTC No. P0011
P0016
(05-69 )
Crankshaft Position - Camshaft
Position Correlation (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Mechanical system (jumped tooth of timing chain, chain
stretched)
ECM
P0031*3
(05-71 )
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater Circuit Low (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Open in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
ECM
P0032*3
(05-71 )
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater Circuit High (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
ECM
P0037
(05-76 )
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control
Circuit Low (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Open or short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater
EFI relay
ECM
P0038
(05-76 )
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control
Circuit High (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Same as DTC No. P0037
P0100
(05-81 )
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit
Mass air flow meter
ECM
P0101
(05-88 )
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit
Range/Performance Problem
Mass air flow meter
P0102
(05-81 )
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit
Low Input
Same as DTC No. P0100
P0103
(05-81 )
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit
High Input
Same as DTC No. P0100
P0110
(05-90 )
Intake Air Temperature Circuit
Open or short in intake air temperature sensor circuit
Intake air temperature sensor (built-in mass air flow meter)
ECM
P0112
(05-90 )
Intake Air Temperature Circuit
Low Input
Same as DTC No. P0110
P0113
(05-90 )
Intake Air Temperature Circuit
High Input
Same as DTC No. P0110
P0115
(05-95 )
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit
Open or short in engine coolant temperature sensor circuit
Engine coolant temperature sensor
ECM
P0116
(05-100 )
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Range/Performance Problem
Cooling system
Engine coolant temperature sensor
P0117
(05-95 )
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Low Input
Same as DTC No. P0115
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
238
05-49
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
P0118
(05-95 )
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit High Input
Same as DTC No. P0115
P0120
(05-102 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”A” Circuit
Throttle position sensor (built-in throttle body)
ECM
P0121
(05-111)
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”A” Circuit Range/Performance Problem
Throttle body assy (Throttle position sensor)
P0122
(05-102 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”A” Circuit Low Input
Throttle position sensor (built-in throttle body)
Short in VTA1 circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
P0123
(05-102 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”A” Circuit High Input
Throttle position sensor (built-in throttle body)
Open in VTA1 circuit
Open in E2 circuit
VC and VTA1 circuits are short-circuited
ECM
P0125
(05-113)
Insufficient Coolant Temperature
for Closed Loop Fuel Control
Cooling system
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Thermostat
P0128
(05-115)
Coolant Thermostat (Coolant
Temperature Below Thermostat
Regulating Temperature)
Thermostat
Cooling system
Engine coolant temperature sensor
ECM
P0136
(05-118)
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) circuit
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 2)
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
P0137
(05-118)
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor circuit (sensor to ECM)
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor internal circuit
P0138
(05-118)
Oxygen Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) circuit
Short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) internal circuit
ECM internal circuit malfunction
System too Lean (Bank 1)
Air induction system
Injector blockage
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and EFI relay circuits
PCV hose connection
PCV hose
System too Rich (Bank 1)
Injector leak, blockage
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Ignition system
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and EFI relay circuits
EFI relay
P0171
(05-132 )
P0172
(05-132 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
239
05-50
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
P0220
(05-102 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”B” Circuit
Throttle position sensor (built-in throttle body)
ECM
P0222
(05-102 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”B” Circuit Low Input
Throttle position sensor (built-in throttle body)
Short in VTA2 circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”B” Circuit High Input
Throttle position sensor (built-in throttle body)
Open in VTA2 circuit
Open in E2 circuit
VC and VTA2 circuits are short-circuited
ECM
P0300
(05-146 )
Random/Multiple Cylinder Misfire
Detected
Open or short in engine wire
Connector connection
Vacuum hose connection
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel pressure
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Compression pressure
Valve clearance
Valve timing
PCV hose connection
PCV hose
ECM
*2
P0301
(05-146 )
Cylinder 1 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC No. P0300
*2
P0302
(05-146 )
Cylinder 2 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC No. P0300
*2
P0303
(05-146 )
Cylinder 3 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC No. P0300
*2
P0304
(05-146 )
Cylinder 4 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC No. P0300
*2
P0325
(05-161 )
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit (Bank 1
or Single Sensor)
Open or short in knock sensor circuit
Knock sensor (under-torqued or loose)
ECM
P0327
(05-161 )
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit Low Input
(Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
Short in knock sensor circuit
Knock sensor
ECM
P0328
(05-161 )
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit High Input (Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
Open in knock sensor circuit
Knock sensor
ECM
P0335
(05-166 )
Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A”
Circuit
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Signal plate (Crankshaft position sensor plate No. 1)
ECM
P0339
(05-166 )
Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A”
Circuit Intermittent
Same as DTC No. P0335
-
P0340
(05-170 )
Camshaft Position Sensor ”A”
Circuit (Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
Open or short in camshaft position sensor circuit
Camshaft position sensor
Camshaft timing gear
Timing chain has a jumped tooth
ECM
P0341
(05-170 )
Camshaft Position Sensor ”A”
Circuit Range/Performance
(Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
Same as DTC No. P0340
P0223
(05-102 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
240
05-51
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
P0351
(05-174 )
Ignition Coil ”A” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF and IGT1 to 4 circuits from ignition coil
with igniter assy to ECM
No.1 - 4 ignition coil assy
ECM
P0352
(05-174 )
Ignition Coil ”B” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Same as DTC No. P0351
P0353
(05-174 )
Ignition Coil ”C” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Same as DTC No. P0351
P0354
(05-174 )
Ignition Coil ”D” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Same as DTC No. P0351
P0420
(05-184 )
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold (Bank 1)
Gas leakage on exhaust system
A/F sensor
Heated oxygen sensor
Exhaust manifold converter (Three way catalytic converter)
P043E
(05-190 )
Evaporative Emission System
Reference Orifice Clog Up
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness (Pump module - ECM)
ECM
Leakage from EVAP system
P043F
(05-190 )
Evaporative Emission System
Reference Orifice High Fow
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness (Pump module - ECM)
ECM
Leakage from EVAP system
P0441
(05-196 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System Incorrent Purge Flow
Purge VSV
Connector/wire harness (Purge VSV - ECM)
ECM
Pump module
Leakage from EVAP system
Leakage from EVAP line (Purge VSV - Intake manifold)
P0450
(05-202 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure sensor/Switch
Pump module
ECM
P0451
(05-202 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure sensor Range/
Performance
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness (Pump module - ECM)
ECM
P0452
(05-202 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure sensor/Switch
Low Input
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness (Pump module to ECM)
ECM
P0453
(05-202 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure sensor/Switch
High Input
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness (Pump module to ECM)
ECM
P0455
(05-211)
Evaporative Emission Control
System Leak Detected (gross
leak)
Fuel tank cap (loose)
Leakage from EVAP line (Canister - Fuel tank)
Leakage from EVAP line (Purge VSV - Canister)
Pump module
Leakage from fuel tank
Leakage from canister
P0456
(05-211)
Evaporative Emission Control
System Leak Detected (small
leak)
Same above
P0500
(05-216 )
Vehicle Speed Sensor ”A”
Combination meter
Open or short in speed sensor circuit
Vehicle speed sensor
ECM
Skid control ECU
P0503
(05-216 )
Vehicle Speed Sensor ”A” Intermittent/Erratic/High
Same as DTC No. P0500
-
Brake Switch Correlation
Short in stop lamp switch signal circuit
STOP fuse
Stop lamp switch
ECM
-
P0504
(05-219 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
241
05-52
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
P0505
(05-226 )
Idle Control System
Electronic throttle control system
Air induction system
PCV hose connection
ECM
P0560
(05-229 )
System Voltage
Open in back-up power source circuit
ECM
P0604
(05-233 )
Internal Control Module Random
Access Memory (RAM) Error
ECM
P0606
(05-233 )
ECM/PCM Processor
Same as DTC No. P0604
P0607
(05-233 )
Control Module Performance
Same as DTC No. P0604
P0617
(05-235 )
Starter Relay Circuit High
Short in PNP switch
PNP switch
Ignition switch
ECM
P0630
(05-241 )
VIN not Programmed or Mismatch - ECM/PCM
ECM
P0657
(05-233 )
Actuator Supply Voltage Circuit /
Open
Same as DTC No. P0604
P0705
(05-242 )
Transmission Range Sensor Circuit Malfunction (PRNDL Input)
Short in PNP switch circuit
PNP switch
ECM
P0710
(05-928 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” circuit
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0711
(05-933 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Performance
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0712
(05-928 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Circuit Low Input
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0713
(05-928 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Circuit High Input
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0717
(05-937 )
Input/Turbine Speed Sensor ”A”
Circuit No Signal
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0724
(05-940 )
Brake Switch ”B” Circuit High
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0741
(05-944 )
Torque Converter Clutch Circuit
Performance or Stuck Off
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0746
(05-949 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”A”
Performance (Shift Solenoid
Valve SL1)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0748
(05-953 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”A”
Electrical (Shift Solenoid Valve
SL1)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0766
(05-949 )
Shift Solenoid ”D” Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve S4)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0776
(05-949 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”B”
Performance (Shift Solenoid
Valve SL2)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0778
(05-953 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”B”
Electrical (Shift Solenoid Valve
SL2)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0793
(05-967 )
Intermediate Shaft Speed Sensor
”A” Circuit No Signal
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0982
(05-953 )
Shift Solenoid ”D” Control Low
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0983
(05-953 )
Shift Solenoid ”D” Control High
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
242
05-53
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Throttle Actuator Control Motor
Circuit Low
Open in throttle actuator circuit
Throttle actuator
ECM
P2103
(05-243 )
Throttle Actuator Control Motor
Circuit High
Short in throttle actuator circuit
Throttle actuator
Throttle valve
Throttle body assy
ECM
P2111
(05-247 )
Throttle Actuator Control System
- Stuck Open
Throttle actuator circuit
Throttle actuator
Throttle body
Throttle valve
P2112
(05-247 )
Throttle Actuator Control System
- Stuck Closed
Same as DTC No. P2111
P2118
(05-250 )
Actuator Control Motor Current
Range/Performance
Open in ETCS power source circuit
ECM
P2119
(05-255 )
Throttle Actuator Control Throttle
Body Range/Performance
Electronic throttle control system
ECM
P2120
(05-257 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”D” Circuit
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in VCP1 circuit
VPA circuit open or ground short
ECM
P2121
(05-265 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”D” Circuit Range/Performance
Open or short in Accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
P2122
(05-257 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”D” Circuit Low Input
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in VCP1 circuit
VPA circuit open or ground short
ECM
P2123
(05-257 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”D” Circuit High Input
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in EPA circuit
ECM
P2125
(05-257 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”E” Circuit
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
P2127
(05-257 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”E” Circuit Low Input
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in VCP2 circuit
VPA2 circuit open or ground short
ECM
P2128
(05-257 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”E” Circuit High Input
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in EPA2 circuit
ECM
P2135
(05-102 )
Throttle Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”A”/”B” Voltage Correlation
Same as DTC No. P0120
P2138
(05-257 )
Throttle Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”D”/”E” Voltage Correlation
VPA and VPA2 circuit are short circuited
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
P2195*3
(05-269 )
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal
Stuck Lean (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and EFI relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
ECM
P2196*3
(05-269 )
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal
Stuck Rich (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P2195
P2102
(05-243 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
243
05-54
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
P2238*3
(05-282 )
Oxygen Sensor Pumping Current
Circuit Low (for A/F sensor)
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and EFI relay circuits
ECM
P2239*3
(05-282 )
Oxygen Sensor Pumping Current
Circuit High (for A/F sensor)
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P2238
P2252*3
(05-282 )
Oxygen Sensor Reference
Ground Circuit Low (for A/F sensor) (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P2238
P2253*3
(05-282 )
Oxygen Sensor Reference
Ground Circuit High (for A/F sensor) (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P2238
P2401
(05-288 )
Evaporative Emission System
Leak Detection Pump Control
Circuit Low
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness (Pump module - ECM)
ECM
Leakage from EVAP system
P2402
(05-288 )
Evaporative Emission System
Leak Detection Pump Control
Circuit High
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness (Pump module - ECM)
ECM
P2419
(05-294 )
Evaporative Emission System
Switching Valve Control Circuit
Low
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness (Pump module - ECM)
ECM
P2420
(05-294 )
Evaporative Emission System
Switching Valve Control Circuit
High
Pump module
Connector/Wire harness (Pump module - ECM)
ECM
Leakage from EVAP system
P2610
(05-300 )
ECM/PCM Internal Engine Off
Timer Performance
ECM
P2716
(05-974 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”D”
Electrical
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P2A00
(05-302 )
A/F Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and EFI relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
ECM
P2769
(05-978 )
DSL Solenoid Circuit Low
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P2770
(05-978 )
DSL Solenoid Circuit High
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
B2799
(05-2010 )
Engine Immobilizer System Malfunction
Immobilizer system
-
HINT:
*1: MIL illuminates
*2: MIL illuminates or flashes continuously
*3: Although the title (DTC description) says ”oxygen sensor”, this DTC is related to the ”A/F sensor”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
244
05-5
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
051ZF-14
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
The hand-held tester is used in steps 3, 4, 5, 7 and 10.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS (See page 05-8 )
NEXT
3
CONNECT HAND-HELD TESTER TO DLC3
HINT:
If the display indicates a communication fault in the tool, inspect the DLC3.
NEXT
4
CHECK DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA (See page 05-38 )
HINT:
Record or print DTC and freeze frame data, if needed.
NEXT
5
CLEAR DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA (See page 05-38 )
NEXT
6
VISUAL INSPECTION
NEXT
7
SETTING CHECK (TEST) MODE DIAGNOSIS (See page 05-40 )
NEXT
8
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
HINT:
If the engine does not start, perform steps 10 and 12 first.
B
Malfunction does not occur
A
Malfunction occurs
B
Go to step 10
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
195
05-6
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
10
DTC CHECK (See page 05-38 )
Malfunction code
A
No code
B
B
Go to step 12
A
11
DTC CHART (See page 05-48 )
NEXT
Go to step 14
12
BASIC INSPECTION (See page 05-10 )
B
Wrong parts not confirmed
A
Wrong parts confirmed
B
Go to step 17
A
13
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (See page 05-31 )
B
Wrong circuit confirmed
A
Wrong parts confirmed
B
Go to step 17
A
14
CHECK ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT (See page 05-312 )
NEXT
15
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
B
Malfunction not confirmed
A
Malfunction confirmed
B
Go to step 18
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
196
05-7
DIAGNOSTICS
16
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS (See page 05-9 )
NEXT
Go to step 18
17
PARTS INSPECTION
NEXT
18
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
19
ADJUSTMENT, REPAIR
NEXT
20
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
197
05-4
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
051ZI-15
LOCATION
Mass Air Flow Sensor
Combination Meter Assy
(Including Intake Air Temperature Sensor)
ECM
R/B Sub-assy:
C/OPN Relay
EVAP VSV
Passenger Side J/B
Engine Room R/B No. 2
and Engine Room J/B
Heated Oxygen Sensor
EFI Relay
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
STARTER Relay
EFI NO. 1 Fuse
Accelerator Pedal Rod Assy
DLC3
EFI NO. 2 Fuse
(Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor)
ETCS Fuse
Ignition Coil
AM2 Fuse
with Igniter
Camshaft Timing Oil
ALT Fuse
Control Valve Assy
STARTER Fuse
Injector
Fuel Pump
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
IGN Fuse
IG2 Fuse
STOP
Charcoal Canister Assy
Front
Pump Module
Throttle Body Assy
(Throttle Position
Sensor and Actuator)
Camshaft Position Sensor
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
Engine Coolant
Temperature Sensor
A/F Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Knock Sensor
PNP Switch
A90309
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
194
05-31
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
051ZK-13
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspected Area
See Page
Engine does not crank (does not start)
1. Starter
2. STARTER relay
3. PNP switch
19-12
19-12
40-6
No initial combustion (does not start)
1. ECM power source circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
3. ECM
05-312
05-349
01-36
No complete combustion (does not start)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
05-349
Difficult to start (engine cranks normally)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
3. Compression
05-235
05-349
14-1
Difficult to start with cold engine
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
05-235
05-349
Difficult to start with hot engine
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
05-235
05-349
High engine idle speed (poor idling)
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor circuit)
2. ECM power source circuit
05-1190
05-312
Low engine idle speed (poor idling)
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor circuit)
2. Fuel pump control circuit
05-1190
05-349
Rough idling (poor idling)
1. Compression
2. Fuel pump control circuit
14-1
05-349
Hunting (poor idling)
1. ECM power source circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
05-312
05-349
Hesitation/Poor acceleration (poor driveability)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
2. A/T faulty
05-349
05-904
Surging (poor driveability)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
05-349
Engine stalls soon after starting
1. Fuel pump control circuit
05-349
Engine stalls during A/C operation
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor circuit)
2. ECM
05-1190
01-36
Unable to refuel/Difficult to refuel
1. ORVR system
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
221
05-32
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
051ZJ-16
TERMINALS OF ECM
E7
E9
E8
E6
E5
A53766
HINT:
Each ECM terminal’s standard voltage is shown in the table below.
In the table, first follow the information under ”Condition”. Next look under ”Symbols (Terminal No.)” for the
terminals to be inspected. The standard voltage between the terminals is shown under ”Specific Condition”.
Use the illustration above as a reference for the ECM terminals.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
BATT (E5-3) - E1 (E9-1)
BR - BR
Battery (for measuring
battery voltage and for
ECM memory)
+BM (E6-6) - E1 (E9-1)
W - BR
Power source of throttle
motor
Always
9 to 14 V
IGSW (E5-9) - E1 (E9-1)
P - BR
Ignition switch
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
+B (E5-1) - E1 (E9-1)
W - BR
Power source of ECM
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
+B2 (E5-2) - E1 (E9-1)
W - BR
Power source of ECM
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
Camshaft timing oil control valve (OCV)
Ignition switch ON
Pulse generation
(see page 05-55 )
OC1+ (E9-16) - OC1- (E9-15)
G-W - G-R
Always
9 to 14 V
MREL (E5-8) - E1 (E9-1)
B - BR
EFI relay
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
VC (E7-18) - E2 (E7-28)
Y - BR
Power source of sensor
(specific voltage)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
VG (E7-30) - EVG (E7-29)
R - L-W
Mass air flow meter
Idling, shift lever position P or N
position, A/C switch OFF
0.5 to 3.0 V
THA (E7-20) - E2 (E7-28)
L-B - BR
Intake air temperature
sensor
Idling, intake air temp. 20°C (68°F)
0.5 to 3.4 V
THW (E7-19) - E2 (E7-28)
G-B - BR
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Idling, engine coolant temp. 80°C
(176°F)
0.2 to 1.0 V
VTA1 (E7-21) - E2 (E7-28)
B-W - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal released
0.3 to 1.0 V
VTA1 (E7-21) - E2 (E7-28)
B-W - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal depressed
3.2 to 4.9 V
VTA2 (E7-31) - E2 (E7-28)
B-R - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for sensor malfunction
detection)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal released
2.1 to 3.1 V
VTA2 (E7-31) - E2 (E7-28)
B-R - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for sensor malfunction
detection)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal depressed
4.5 to 5.5 V
VPA (E5-22) - EPA (E5-28)
B -R
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal released
0.5 to 1.1 V
VPA (E5-22) - EPA (E5-28)
B -R
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
W - BR
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for sensor malfunction detection)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal released
1.2 to 2.0 V
VPA2 (E5-23) - EPA2 (E5-29)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
222
05-33
DIAGNOSTICS
Symbols (Terminal No.)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
VPA2 (E5-23) - EPA2 (E5-29)
W - BR
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for sensor malfunction detection)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal depressed
3.4 to 5.3 V
VCPA (E5-26) - EPA (E5-28)
G-R
Power source of accelerator pedal position sensor
(for VPA)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
VCP2 (E5-27) - EPA2 (E5-29)
L - BR
Power source of accelerator pedal position sensor
(for VPA2)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
Below 3.0 V
HA1A (E8-5) - E04 (E8-7)
B-W - W-B
A/F sensor heater
Idling
HA1A (E8-5) - E04 (E8-7)
B-W - W-B
A/F sensor heater
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
A1A+ (E8-23) - E1 (E9-1)
BR - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.0 to 3.6 V
A1A- (E8-31) - E1 (E9-1)
Y - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
2.7 to 3.3 V
Idling
Below 3.0 V
HT1B (E8-21) - E1 (E9-1)
R-Y - BR
Heated oxygen sensor
heater
HT1B (E8-21) - E1 (E9-1)
R-Y - BR
Heated oxygen sensor
heater
IIgnition switch ON
G - BR
Heated oxygen sensor
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm
for 2 minutes after warming up
OX1B (E8-29) - O1B (E8-2)
9 to 14 V
Pulse generation
#1
#2
#3
#4
(E7-1)
(E7-2)
(E7
2)
(E7-3)
(E7-4)
-
E01
E01
E01
E01
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
(E7
7)
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
L - W-B
Y - W
W-B
B
B - W-B
W - W-B
Injector
IIgnition switch
s itch ON
#1
#2
#3
#4
(E7-1)
(E7-2)
(E7-3)
(E7-4)
-
E01
E01
E01
E01
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
L - W-B
Y - W-B
B - W-B
W - W-B
Injector
Idling
Pulse generation
(see page 05-146 )
9 to 14 V
KNK1 (E8-1) - FKNK1 (E8-28)
B -W
Knock sensor
Maintain engine speed at 4,000 rpm
after warming up
Pulse generation
(see page 05-161 )
G2+ (E9-27) - NE- (E9-24)
Y -G
Camshaft position sensor
Idling
Pulse generation
(see page 05-166 )
NE+ (E9-25) - NE- (E9-24)
R -G
Crankshaft position sensor
Idling
Pulse generation
(see page 05-166 )
Pulse generation
(see page 05-174 )
IGT1
IGT2
IGT3
IGT4
(E7-8) - E1 (E9-1)
(E7-9) - E1 (E9-1)
(E7-10) - E1 (E9-1)
(E7-11) - E1 (E9-1)
R-W - BR
P - BR
Y-B - BR
L-Y - BR
Ignition coil with igniter
(ignition signal)
Idling
IGF1 (E7-24) - E1 (E9-1)
W-R - BR
Ignition coil with igniter
(ignition confirmation signal)
IIgnition switch ON
IGF1 (E7-24) - E1 (E9-1)
W-R - BR
Ignition coil with igniter
(ignition confirmation signal)
Idling
PRG (E7-34) - E1 (E9-1)
G - BR
Purge valve
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
Pulse generation
(see page 05-174 )
VPMP (E7-27) - E1 (E9-1)
Y-G - BR
Vent valve
(Build in pump module)
MPMP (E5-4) - E1 (E9-1)
LG - BR
Vacuum pump
(Build in pump module)
Vacuum pump OFF
0 to 3 V
MPMP (E5-4) - E1 (E9-1)
LG - BR
Vacuum pump
(Build in pump module)
Vacuum pump ON
9 to 14 V
PPMP (E5-21) - E2 (E7-28)
L - BR
Pressure sensor
(Build in pump module)
Ignition switch ON
3 to 3.6 V
SPD (E6-17) - E1 (E9-1)
Y - BR
Speed signal from combination meter
Ignition switch ON, rotate driving
wheel slowly
Pulse generation
(see page 05-216 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
223
05-34
DIAGNOSTICS
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
Starter signal
Shift lever position P or N, ignition
switch START
BR - BR
Stop lamp switch
Brake pedal is depressed
7 5 to 14 V
7.5
BR - BR
Stop lamp switch
Brake pedal is released
Below 1.5 V
ST1 (E6-12) - E1 (E9-1)
V - BR
Stop lamp switch
Ignition switch ON, Brake pedal is
depressed
Below 1.5 V
ST1 (E6-12) - E1 (E9-1)
V - BR
Stop lamp switch
Ignition switch ON, Brake pedal is
released
7.5 to 14 V
NSW (E7-16) - E1 (E9-1)
B-R - BR
PNP switch
Ignition switch ON, shift position at
P or N
0 to 3.0 V
NSW (E7-16) - E1 (E9-1)
B-R - BR
PNP switch
Ignition switch ON, shift position is
not P or N
9 to 14 V
M+ (E9-3) - ME01 (E9-4)
B - W-B
Throttle actuator
Idling
Pulse generation
M- (E9-2) - ME01 (E9-4)
W - W-B
Throttle actuator
Idling
Pulse generation
STA (E7-17) - E1 (E9-1)
B - BR
STP (E6-19)
(E6 19) - E1 (E9-1)
(E9 1)
STP (E6-19) - E1 (E9-1)
9 to 14 V
FC (E5-10) - E1 (E9-1)
Y - BR
Fuel pump control
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
W (E5-11) - E1 (E9-1)
SB - BR
MIL
Ignition switch ON
Below 3.0 V
W (E5-11) - E1 (E9-1)
SB - BR
MIL
Idling
ELS2 (E5-12) - E1 (E9-1)
G - BR
Electric load
Power outlet OFF
0 to 1.5 V
ELS2 (E5-12) - E1 (E9-1)
G - BR
Electric load
Power outlet ON
7.5 to 14 V
TC (E5-20) - E1 (E9-1)
O - BR
Terminal TC of DLC3
Ignition switch ON
SIL (E5-18) - E1 (E9-1)
R - BR
Terminal SIL of DLC3
During charge of gears
Pulse generation
TACH (E5-5) - E1 (E9-1)
B - BR
Engine speed
Idling
Pulse generation
PSW (E9-10) - E1 (E9-1)
R-L - BR
PS oil pressure switch
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
9 to 14 V
9 to 14 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
224
05-660
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EY4-05
ACIS CONTROL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM opens and closes the Intake Air Control (IAC) valve No. 2 in response to engine speed (RPM/NE).
This system improves intake manifold tuning for better efficiency at low and high engine rpm. When the engine speed is 4,000 rpm or less and the throttle valve opening angle is 30 or more, the ECM turns the VSV
ON to operate the IAC valve.
HINT:
ACIS stands for ”Acoustic Control Induction System”.
Throttle Valve
Opening Angle
Valve closed (VSV: ON)
IAC
Valve
No. 2
30°
Throttle Valve
4,000 rpm
Engine Speed
A87796
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
850
05-661
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
V2
VSV for IAC
Valve No. 2
Engine Room R/B No. 2
EFI NO. 2
2
2
1
B-W
1
EB1
2
ECM
R-Y
B-R
1
2
13
IK3
B
15
ACIS
E7
Y
Engine Room J/B
3
2D
3 EFI Relay
1
5
2
5
2B
P-L
BR
EFI NO. 1
1
2I
8
MREL
E5
4
1
E7 E1
2F
W
3
W-B
F7
FL Block
Assy
1
A
A
W
J7
J/C
J2
J/C
A
FL
Main
BR
Battery
ED
EH
A88701
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
851
05-662
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Hand-held tester:
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER (OPERATE VSV FOR IAC
VALVE NO. 2)
VSV is ON
Air
VSV is OFF
Air
Air
Filter
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Port F
Port E
Port F
(e)
Port E
A67588
Disconnect the vacuum hose.
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / INTAKE CTL VSV1. Operate the
VSV.
Check the VSV operation when it is operated by the
hand-held tester.
OK:
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
VSV is ON
Air from port E flows out through port F
VSV is OFF
Air from port E flows out through the air filter
OK
Go to step 4
NG
2
CHECK VSV FOR IAC VALVE NO.2 (OPERATION)
Air
(a)
(a)
Check that air flows from port E to the air filter.
(b)
(c)
Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
Check that air flows from port E to port F.
Air Filter
Port E
A54315
(b)
Air
Port E
Port F
Battery
A54316
NG
REPLACE VSV
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
852
05-663
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (VSV FOR IAC VALVE NO. 2 - ECM, VSF FOR IAC VALVE
NO. 2 - EFI RELAY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
V2
VSV for IAC Valve No. 2
Check the wire harness between the VSV and ECM.
(1) Disconnect the V2 VSV connector.
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V2-2 - E7-15 (ACIS)
Below 1 Ω
V2-2 or E7-15 (ACIS) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E7
ECM
Y
A85675
A81699
ACIS
A87763
(b)
Wire Harness Side
V2
VSV for IAC Valve No. 2
Check the wire harness between the VSV and EFI relay.
(1) Disconnect the V2 VSV connector.
(2) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V2-1 - J/B EFI relay terminal 3
Below 1 Ω
Engine Room J/B
EFI Relay
A85448
A90291
A92391
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
853
05-664
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK VACUUM HOSES (INTAKE MANIFOLD - INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE,
INTAKE AIR CONTROL)
Check that the vacuum hoses are:
Connected correctly.
Are not loose or disconnected.
Do not have cracks, holes or damage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE VACUUM HOSES
OK
5
INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE (See page 13-2 )
NG
REPLACE INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
INSPECT VSV FOR IAC VALVE NO.2 (OPERATION)
(a)
(b)
Air
(a)
Air Filter
Port E
Disconnect the VSV connector.
Check operation of the VSV when battery positive voltage
is applied to the terminals of the VSV.
OK:
Battery positive voltage is not applied:
Air from port E flows out through the air filter.
Battery positive voltage is applied:
Air from port E flows out through port F.
(b)
Air
Port E
Y
A54315
A54316
Port F
Battery
A87791
NG
REPLACE VSV
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
854
05-665
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK ECM (ACIS VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
(a)
(b)
Start the engine.
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard
Tester Connection
Condition
E7-15 (ACIS)
- E9-1 (E1)
ACIS (+)
E7
ECM
E9
ECM
A76903
OK
Specified Condition
Engine speed is 4,000
rpm or less
Throttle valve opening
angle is 30 or more
9 to 14 V
Go to step 4
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
855
05-666
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (VSV FOR IAC VALVE NO. 2 - ECM, VSV FOR IAC VALVE
NO.2 - EFI RELAY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
V2
VSV for IAC Valve No. 2
Check the wire harness between the VSV and ECM.
(1) Disconnect the V2 VSV connector.
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V2-2 - E7-15 (ACIS)
Below 1 Ω
V2-2 or E7-15 (ACIS) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E7
ECM
Y
A85675
A81699
ACIS
A87763
(b)
Wire Harness Side
V2
VSV for IAC Valve No. 2
Check the wire harness between the VSV and EFI relay.
(1) Disconnect the V2 VSV connector.
(2) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
(3) Check the resistance OF the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V2-1 (VSV for ACIS) - J/B EFI relay terminal 3
Below 1 Ω
Engine Room J/B
EFI Relay
A85448
A90291
A92391
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
856
05-667
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK VACUUM HOSES (INTAKE MANIFOLD - INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE,
INTAKE AIR CONTROL)
Check that the vacuum hoses are:
Connected correctly.
Are not loose or disconnected.
Do not have cracks, holes or damage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE VACUUM HOSE
OK
5
INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE (See page 13-2 )
NG
REPLACE INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
857
05-668
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXI-05
ACTIVE CONTROL ENGINE MOUNT
LOCATION
Vacuum Tank
Air Cleaner Cap
Engine Mounting Insulator FR
Engine Room J/B
EFI NO. 1 Fuse
EFI Relay
A87847
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
858
05-669
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Active Control Engine Mount (ACM) system decreases engine vibration at low engine speed using the
VSV for ACM. The VSV is controlled by a pulse signal transmitted to the VSV from the ECM. The frequency
of this pulse signal is matched to the engine speed to decrease engine vibration.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
V5
VSV for ACM
Engine Room R/B No. 2
EFI NO. 2
2
B-W
2
1
B
2
1
2
7
EB2
Y-G
6
ACM
E9
Y
Engine Room J/B
3
2D
5
2B
3 EFI Relay
1
5
2
P-L
13
IK3
B
8
MREL
E5
EFI NO. 1
1
2I
4
2F
W
3
W-B
F7
FL Block
Assy
1
A
W
J2
J/C
FL
Main
Battery
EH
A88702
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
859
05-670
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK VACUUM HOSES
Vacuum Tank
IAC Valve
Actuator
(a)
(b)
(c)
Air Cleaner
Check if the vacuum hose cap is missing.
If the hose is damaged, replace the vacuum hose assembly.
Check the air and vacuum hoses for looseness, disconnection and blockage.
ECM
Engine
A
Cap
B
VSV
Front Engine Mount Insulator
C
A61613
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE VACUUM HOSES
OK
2
CHECK VACUUM
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
A61611
Start the engine.
Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vacuum tank.
Check that the unconnected port located on the vacuum
tank applies suction to your finger.
Reconnect the vacuum hose.
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE VACUUM SOURCE AND
HOSES
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
860
05-671
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM (ACM VOLTAGE)
(a)
ACM (+)
E1 (-)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the oscilloscope between terminals ACM and E1
of the E9 ECM connector.
Warm up engine to normal operating temperature.
Turn the A/C switch on.
Measure the voltage between terminals ACM and E1 of
the E9 ECM connector.
Result:
E9
ECM
Condition
Voltage
Shift position is D range, and
engine speed is 850 rpm or less
Pulse generation
Shift position is D range, and
engine speed is 950 rpm or more
9 to 14 V
Shift position is P range
9 to 14 V
5 V/
Division
GND
10 V/Division
A88570
OK
Go to step 6
NG
4
INSPECT VSV FOR ACM (RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the V5 VSV connector.
Measure the resistance between the terminals 1 and 2.
Standard: 19 to 21 Ω at 20C (68F)
V5
VSV for
ACM
2
1
C58536
NG
REPLACE VSV
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
861
05-672
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (VSV FOR ACM - ECM, VSV FOR ACM - EFI RELAY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
V5
VSV for ACM
Check the wire harness between the VSV and ECM.
(1) Disconnect the V5 VSV connector for ACM.
(2) Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V5-2 - E9-6 (ACM)
Below 1 Ω
V5-2 or E9-6 (ACM) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E9
ECM
ACM
A87797
(b)
Wire Harness Side
V5
VSV for ACM
Check the wire harness between the VSV and EFI relay.
(1) Disconnect the V5 VSV connector.
(2) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V5-1 (VSV for ACM) - J/B EFI relay terminal 3
Below 1 Ω
Engine Room J/B
EFI Relay
A85448
A90291
A92392
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
862
05-673
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT VSV FOR ACM (OPERATION)
(a)
(b)
G
E
F
HH
G
Remove the VSV.
Check operation of the VSV when battery positive voltage
is applied to the terminals of the VSV connector.
OK:
Battery positive voltage is not applied:
The air from pipe G is flowing out through pipes E and
H.
Battery positive voltage is applied:
The air from pipe F is flowing out through pipes E and
H.
E
F
HH
A52014
NG
REPLACE VSV FOR ACM
OK
7
INSPECT TRANSVERSE ENGINE ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
A51989
Disconnect the vacuum hose from the front engine mount
insulator.
Using MITYVAC (hand-held vacuum pump), apply a vacuum of 80 kPa (600 mmHg, 25 in.Hg) and wait for 1 minute.
Make sure there is no needle movement on the MITYVAC.
Check that there is no fluid leakage caused by a broken
lower diaphragm.
NG
REPLACE TRANSVERSE
MOUNTING INSULATOR
ENGINE ENGINE
OK
SYSTEM OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
863
05-371
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EX3-05
BASIC INSPECTION
When the malfunction is not confirmed in the DTC check, troubleshooting should be carried out in all the
possible circuits considered as possible causes of the problem. In many cases, by carrying out the basic
engine check shown in the following flowchart, the problem can be found quickly and efficiently. Therefore,
using this check is essential in the engine troubleshooting.
1
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
NOTICE:
Carry out the battery voltage check with the engine stopped and ignition switch OFF.
Voltage
NG
OK
NG
11 V or more
Less than 11 V
CHARGE OR REPLACE BATTERY
OK
2
CHECK IF ENGINE WILL CRANK
NG
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
ON PAGE 05-393
NG
Go to step 6
OK
3
CHECK IF ENGINE STARTS
OK
4
CHECK AIR FILTER
Visually check if the air filter is not contaminated dirty or oily.
NG
CLEAN OR REPLACE
OK
5
CHECK IDLE SPEED (See page 14-121 )
NG
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
ON PAGE 05-393
OK
6
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE (See page 11-38 )
NG
PROCEED TO PAGE 05-393 AND CONTINUE TO
TROUBLESHOOT
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
561
05-372
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK FOR SPARK (See page 18-7 )
NG
PROCEED TO PAGE 05-393 AND CONTINUE TO
TROUBLESHOOT
OK
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE ON PAGE 05-393
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
562
05-385
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05MOM-01
CHECKING MONITOR STATUS
NOTICE:
The monitor status (mode 6) is not applicable to the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S). However, HO2S
test values can be checked by O2S TEST RESULT (mode 5). Refer to page 05-383
1.
Outline
The monitor results and the test values can be checked with the OBDII scan tool.
The engine control module (ECM) monitors the emissions-related components as the thermostat, catalyst
converter and evaporative emissions (EVAP), and determines whether they are functioning normally or not.
When finished monitoring, the ECM stores the monitor results and the test values.
The monitor result indicates whether the component is functioning normally or not. The test value is the value
that was used to determine the monitor result. If the test value is outside the test limit (malfunction criterion),
the ECM determines the component is malfunctioning. Some emissions-related components have multiple
test values to determine monitor result. If one of these test values is outside test limit, the ECM determines
the component is malfunctioning.
2.
Description
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. This information is
included under ”MONITOR RESULT” in the emissions-related DTC sections:
TID $08: Thermostat
TLT
CID
Unit Conversion
1
$01
Multiply by 0.625 and
subtract 40 [C]
Description of Test Value
Description of Test Limit
ECT sensor output when estimated ECT Malfunction criterion for thermostat
has reached to malfunction criterion
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBDII scan tools.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
575
05-386
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Procedure (using hand-held tester)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch and hand-held tester ON.
Clear DTCs.
Allow the vehicle to drive, in accordance with the applicable drive pattern described in the READINESS
MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN section (see page 05-387 ).
(e)
MONITOR RESULT
CATALYST#1 B1 . INCMP
CATALYST#1 B2 . INCMP
O2S HEAT B1S1 . INCMP
O2S HEAT B1S2 . INCMP
O2S HEAT B2S1 . INCMP
O2S HEAT B2S2 . INCMP
THERMOSTAT . . . . . PASS
Press [ENTER] to
Select the Label .
Select the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED OBDII, MONITOR INFO and MONITOR RESULT. The monitor result appears after the component
name.
INCMP indicates the component has not been monitored
yet.
PASS indicates the component is functioning normally.
FAIL indicates the component is malfunctioning.
A82674
(f)
Thermostat malfunction
VAL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119.375C
LMT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75.000C
TLT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
(g)
[HELP] to notice
[EXIT] to return
A82675
Select the component and press ENTER. If the monitor
result has been PASS or FAIL, the accuracy test value appears.
VAL indicates the test value.
LMT indicates the test limit (malfunction criterion).
TLT indicates the test limit type.
Compare the test value with the test limit.
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test
value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test
value is lower than the test limit.
If the test value is on the borderline of the test limit, a malfunction is concealed in the component.
HINT:
The monitor result might on rare occasions be PASS even if the
malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is illuminated. This indicates
the system malfunctioned on a previous driving cycle. This
might be caused by an intermittent problem.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
576
05-370
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EX2-05
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
Inspect the vehicle’s ECM using check mode. Intermittent problems are easier to detect when the ECM is
in check mode with hand-held tester. In check mode, the ECM uses 1 trip detection logic, which has a higher
sensitivity to malfunctions than normal mode (default), which uses 2 trip detection logic.
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page 05-400 ).
(b) Set the check mode (see page 05-402 ).
(c) Perform a simulation test (see page 01-26 ).
(d) Check the connector and terminal (see page 01-36 ).
(e) Wiggle the harness and the connector (see page 01-36 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
560
05-402
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05IQI-02
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
Check mode has a higher sensitivity to detect malfunctions and
can detect malfunctions that normal mode cannot detect.
Check mode can also detect all the malfunctions that normal
mode can detect.
Hand-held Tester
DLC3
A80020
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
Make sure that the items below are true:
(1) Battery positive voltage 11 V or more
(2) Throttle valve fully closed
(3) Transmission in the P or N position
(4) A/C switched OFF
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
(e)
0.13 seconds
ON
OFF
0.13 seconds
A76900
Change the ECM to check mode with the hand-held tester. Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / CHECK MODE. Make sure the MIL
flashes as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
All DTCs and freeze frame data recorded will be erased if:
1) the hand-held tester is used to change the ECM from
normal mode to check mode or vice-versa; or 2) during
check mode, the ignition switch is turned from ON to ACC
or OFF.
(f)
Start the engine. The MIL should turn off after the engine
starts.
(g) Simulate the conditions of the malfunction described by
the customer.
(h) After simulating the malfunction conditions, use the
hand-held tester diagnosis selector to check the DTC,
freeze frame data and other data.
(i)
After checking the DTC, inspect the applicable circuit.
2.
CLEAR DTC (Using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held
tester)
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to
the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Erase DTCs and freeze frame data with the OBD II scan
tool (complying with SAE J1978) or the hand-held tester.
For the hand-held tester: 1) enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CLEAR
CODES; and 2) press YES. For the OBD II scan tool, see
its instruction manual.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
592
05-403
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
Engine Room J/B
(a)
EFI NO. 1
Engine Room R/B No. 2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CLEAR DTC (Not using the OBD II scan tool or handheld tester)
Remove the EFI NO. 1 fuse from the engine room J/B and
ETCS fuse from the engine room R/B No. 2 for more than
60 seconds.or, disconnect the battery cable for more than
60 seconds.
After disconnecting the battery terminal, perform the ”INITIALIZE” procedure (see page 05-1005 ).
ETCS
A87843
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
593
05-362
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EX0-05
DEFINITION OF TERMS
Term
Definition
Monitor description
Description of what the ECM monitors and how it detects malfunctions (monitoring purpose and its details).
Related DTCs
A group of diagnostic trouble codes that are output by the ECM based on the same malfunction detection logic.
Typical enabling condition
Preconditions that allow the ECM to detect malfunctions.
With all preconditions satisfied, the ECM sets the DTC when the monitored value(s) exceeds the malfunction
threshold(s).
Sequence of operation
The priority order that is applied to monitoring, if multiple sensors and components are used to detect the malfunction.
When a sensor is being monitored, the next sensor or component will not be monitored until the current sensor
monitoring is finished.
Required sensor/components
The sensors and components that are used by the ECM to detect malfunctions.
Frequency of operation
The number of times that the ECM checks for malfunctions per driving cycle.
”Once per driving cycle” means that the ECM detects the malfunction only one time during a single driving cycle.
”Continuous” means that the ECM detects the malfunction every time an enabling condition is met.
Duration
The minimum time that the ECM must sense a continuous deviation in the monitored value(s) before setting a
DTC. This timing begins after the ”typical enabling conditions” are met.
Malfunction thresholds
Beyond this value, the ECM will conclude that there is a malfunction and set a DTC.
MIL operation
MIL illumination timing after a defect is detected.
”Immediately” means that the ECM illuminates the MIL the instant the ECM determines that there is a malfunction.
”2 driving cycle” means that the ECM illuminates the MIL if the same malfunction is detected again in the 2nd driving cycle.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
552
05-397
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EX6-05
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
FI0534
Hand-held Tester
DLC3
DESCRIPTION
When troubleshooting On-Board Diagnostic (OBD II) vehicles, the vehicle must be connected to the OBD II scan
tool (in compliance with SAE J1978) or the hand-held
tester. Various data output from the vehicle’s ECM can
then be read.
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle’s on-board
computer illuminates the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer detects
a malfunction in: 1) the emission control system / components, or 2) the powertrain control components (which affect vehicle emissions), or 3) the computer. In addition,
the applicable Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the ECM memory
(see page 05-412 ).
If the malfunction does not reoccur in 3 consecutive trips, the
MIL goes off automatically but the DTCs remain recorded in the
ECM memory.
A80020
To check DTCs, connect the hand-held tester or OBD II
scan tool to the Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3) of the vehicle. The hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool also enables you to erase the DTC and check the freeze frame
data and various forms of engine data (see the instruction
manual for the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester).
The DTC includes SAE controlled codes and manufacturer controlled codes. SAE controlled codes must be set according to the SAE, while manufacturer controlled codes
can be set by a manufacturer with certain restrictions (see
the DTC chart on page 05-412 ).
The diagnosis system operates in ”normal mode” during
normal vehicle use. In ”normal mode”, 2 trip detection logic* is used to ensure accurate detection of malfunctions.
A ”check mode”, is also available to technicians as an option. In ”check mode”, 1 trip detection logic is used for simulating malfunction symptoms and increasing the system’s ability to detect malfunctions, including intermittent
malfunctions (hand-held tester only)
(see page 05-402 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
587
05-398
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
*2 trip detection logic:
When a malfunction is first detected, the malfunction is
temporarily stored in the ECM memory (1st trip). If the
ignition switch is turned OFF and then ON again, and the
same malfunction is detected again, the MIL will illuminate (2nd trip).
Freeze frame data:
The freeze frame data records the engine conditions (fuel
system, calculated load, engine coolant temperature, fuel
trim, engine speed, vehicle speed, etc.) when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data
can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped,
if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio
was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Priorities for troubleshooting:
When multiple DTCs occur, find out the order in which the DTCs
should be inspected by checking the component’s DTC chart.
If no instructions are written in the DTC chart, check DTCs in the
following order of priority:
(a) DTCs other than fuel trim malfunction DTCs (P0171,
P0172, P0174 and P0175) and misfire DTCs (P0300 to
P0306).
(b) Fuel trim malfunction DTCs (P0171, P0172, P0174 and
P0175).
(c) Misfire DTCs (P0300 to P0306).
2.
DLC3
CG
SG
SIL
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 1314 1516
CHECK DLC3
The vehicle’s ECM uses the ISO 9141-2 for communication protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 9141-2 format.
BAT
A82779
Symbol
Terminal No.
Name
Reference terminal
Result
Condition
SIL
7
Bus ”+” line
5 - Signal ground
Pulse generation
During transmission
CG
4
Chassis ground
Body ground
1 Ω or less
Always
SG
5
Signal ground
Body ground
1 Ω or less
Always
BAT
16
Battery positive
Body ground
9 to 14 V
Always
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
588
05-399
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
HINT:
Connect the cable of the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to the DLC3, turn the ignition switch ON and attempt to use
the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool. If the screen displays UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE, a problem exists
in the vehicle side or the tester side.
If the communication is normal when the tool is connected
to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on the original vehicle.
If the communication is still impossible when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in
the tool itself. Consult the Service Department listed in the
tool’s instruction manual.
3.
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard: 11 to 14 V
If voltage is below 11 V, recharge the battery before proceeding.
4.
CHECK MIL
(a) The MIL turns on when the ignition switch is turned ON
and the engine is not running.
HINT:
If the MIL does not turn on, troubleshoot the MIL circuit (see
page 05-727 ).
(b) When the engine is started, the MIL should not turn off.
If the lamp remains on, the diagnosis system has detected a malfunction or abnormality in the system.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
589
05-406
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
05EXA-04
DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST
1.
DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the hand-held tester DATA LIST allows switch, sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in troubleshooting is one way to shorten labor time.
NOTICE:
In the table below, the values listed under ”Normal Condition” are reference values. Do not depend
solely on these reference values when deciding whether a part is faulty or not.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(e) Turn ON the hand-held tester.
(f)
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST.
(g) According to the display on tester, read the ”DATA LIST”.
Hand-held Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition *
Diagnostic Note
INJECTOR
Injection period of the No. 1 cylinder/
Minimum: 0 ms, Maximum: 32.64
ms
Idling: 1.5 to 2.8 ms
IGN ADVANCE
Ignition timing advance for No. 1
cylinder/
Minimum: -64 deg., Maximum:
63.5 deg.
Idling: BTDC 5 to 25°
CALC LOAD
Calculated load by ECM/
Minimum: 0 %, Maximum: 100 %
Idling: 10.4 to 15.6 %
Running without load (2,500
rpm): 12.1 to 18.2 %
Air flow rate from MAF meter/
Minimum: 0 gm/s, Maximum: 655
gm/s
Idling: 2.0 to 3.7 gm/s
Running without load (2,500
rpm): 2.4 to 4.3 gm/s
If value is approximately 0.0 gm/s:
Mass air flow meter power
source circuit open
VG circuit open or short
If value is 160.0 gm/s or more:
E2G circuit open
ENGINE SPD
Engine speed/
Minimum: 0 rpm, Maximum:
16,383 rpm
Idling: 580 to 750 rpm
COOLANT TEMP
Coolant temperature/
Minimum: -40C, Maximum:
140C
After warming up: 80 to 97°C
(176 to 207°F)
INTAKE AIR
Intake air temperature/
Minimum: -40C, Maximum:
140C
Equivalent to ambient temp.
(after cold soak)
Absolute throttle position sensor/
Minimum: 0 %, Maximum: 100 %
Throttle fully closed: 10 to 24 %
Throttle fully open: 64 to 96 %
Closed throttle position switch/
ON or OFF
Throttle fully closed: ON
Throttle open: OFF
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed/
Minimum: 0 km/h, Maximum: 255
km/h
Actual vehicle speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
ACCEL POS #1
Accelerator pedal position sensor
No.1 output voltage/
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 5 V
Accelerator pedal released:
0.5 to 1.1 V
Accelerator pedal depressed:
2.6 to 4.5 V
Read value with ignition switch ON
(do not start engine)
MAF
THROTTLE POS
CTP SW
Author:
If value is -40C (-40F): sensor
circuit is o
open
en
If value is 140C (284F or
more): sensor circuit is shorted
Read value with ignition switch ON
(do not start engine)
Date:
596
05-407
DIAGNOSTICS
Hand-held Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
Normal Condition *
Diagnostic Note
ACCEL POS #2
Accelerator pedal position sensor
No. 2 output voltage/
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 5 V
Accelerator pedal released:
1.2 to 2.0 V
Accelerator pedal depressed:
3.4 to 5.3 V
Read value with ignition switch ON
(do not start engine)
THROTTLE POS #2
Throttle position sensor No. 2 output voltage/ Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 5 V
Throttle fully closed: 2.1 to 3.1 V
Throttle fully open: 4.5 to 5.5 V
Read value with ignition switch ON
(do not start engine)
THROTTLE TARGT
Target position of throttle valve/
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 5 V
Idling: 0.4 to 1.1 V
THROTTLE OPN DUTY
Throttle motor opening duty ratio/
Minimum: 0 %, Maximum: 100 %
Throttle fully closed: 0 %
When accelerator pedal is depressed, duty ratio is increased
Read value with ignition switch
ON
(do not start engine)
THROTTLE CLS DUTY
Throttle motor closed duty ratio/
Minimum: 0 %, Maximum: 100 %
Throttle fully open: 0 %
When accelerator pedal is released quickly, duty ratio is increased
Read the value with ignition
switch ON
(do not start engine)
THROTTLE MOT
Whether or not throttle motor control is permitted/ ON or OFF
Idling: ON
Read value with ignition switch ON
(do not start engine)
+BM
Whether or not electric throttle
control system power is inputted/
ON or OFF
Idling: ON
ACCEL IDL POS
Whether or not accelerator pedal
position sensor is detecting idle/
ON or OFF
Idling: ON
Whether or not throttle position
sensor is detecting idle/
ON or OFF
Idling: ON
FAIL #1
Whether or not fail safe function is
executed/ ON or OFF
ETCS has failed: ON
FAIL #2
Whether or not fail safe function is
executed/ ON or OFF
ETCS has failed: ON
THROTTLE INITIAL
Throttle fully closed
(learned value)
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 5 V
0.5 to 0.9 V
ACCEL LEARN VAL
Accelerator fully closed
(learned value)
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 5 V
0.4 to 0.8 V
Throttle motor current
Minimum: 0 A, Maximum: 20 A
Idling: 0 to 3.0 A
O2S B1 S2
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage for bank 1 sensor 2/
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 1.0 V
Driving (31 mph, 50 km/h):
0.1 to 0.9 V
Performing INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL function of ACTIVE TEST
enables the technician to check
voltage output of each sensor
O2S B2 S2
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage for bank 2 sensor 2/
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 1.0 V
Driving (31 mph, 50 km/h):
0.1 to 0.9 V
Performing INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL function of ACTIVE TEST
enables the technician to check
voltage output of each sensor
AFS B1 S1
A/F sensor output voltage for bank
1 sensor 1/
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 7.999 V
Idling 2.8 to 3.8 V
Performing INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL function of ACTIVE TEST
enables the technician to check
voltage output of each sensor
THROTTLE IDL POS
THROTTLE MOT
Author:
Date:
597
05-408
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
Hand-held Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
AFS B2 S1
A/F sensor output voltage for bank
2 sensor 1/
Minimum: 0 V, Maximum: 7.999 V
Idling 2.8 to 3.8 V
Performing INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL function of ACTIVE TEST
enables the technician to check
voltage output of each sensor
VAPOR PRESS
Vapor Pressure/
Minimum: -4.125 kPa, Maximum:
2.125 kPa
Fuel tank cap removed: 0 kPa
Pressure inside of fuel tank as
read by the vapor pressure sensor
SHORT FT #1
Short term fuel trim of bank 1/
Minimum: -100 %, Maximum: 100
%
0 ± 20 %
This item is short-term fuel compensation used to maintain air-fuel
ratio at stoichiometric air-fuel ratio
This item is overall, long-term fuel
compensation that helps to maintain air-fuel ratio at stoichiometric
air-fuel ratio (steadies long term
deviations of short-term fuel trim
from central value)
Normal Condition *
Diagnostic Note
LONG FT #1
Long term fuel trim of bank 1/
Minimum: -100 %, Maximum: 100
%
0 ± 20 %
TOTAL FT #1
Total fuel trim of bank 1:
Average value for fuel trim system
of bank 1/
Minimum: 0.5, Maximum: 1.496
Idling: 0.5 to 1.4
SHORT FT #2
Short term fuel trim of bank 2/
Minimum: -100 %, Maximum: 100
%
0 ± 20 %
This item is short-term fuel compensation used to maintain air-fuel
ratio at stoichiometric air-fuel ratio
This item is overall, long-term fuel
compensation that helps to maintain air-fuel ratio at stoichiometric
air-fuel ratio (steadies long term
deviation of short-term fuel trim
from central value)
LONG FT #2
Long term fuel trim of bank 2/
Minimum: -100 %, Maximum: 100
%
0 ± 20 %
TOTAL FT #2
Total fuel trim of bank 2:
Average value for fuel trim system
of bank 2/
Minimum: 0.5, Maximum: 1.496
Idling: 0.5 to 1.4
O2FT B1 S2
Short term fuel trim associated
with the bank 1 sensor 2/
Minimum: -100 %, Maximum: 100
%
0 ± 20 %
Same as SHORT FT #1
O2FT B2 S2
Short term fuel trim associated
with the bank 2 sensor 2/
Minimum: -100 %, Maximum: 100
%
0 ± 20 %
Same as SHORT FT #2
AF FT B1 S1
Short term fuel trim associated
with bank 1 sensor 1/
Minimum: 0, Maximum: 1.999
Value less than 1 (0.000 to
0.999) = Lean
Stoichiometric air-fuel ratio = 1
Value greater than 1 (1.001 to
1.999) = Rich
AF FT B2 S1
Short term fuel trim associated
with bank 2 sensor 1/
Minimum: 0, Maximum: 1.999
Lean: 0 AF FT B2 S1 < 1
Stoichiometric air-fuel ratio = 1
Rich: 1 AF FT B2 S1< 1.999
Author:
Date:
598
05-409
DIAGNOSTICS
Hand-held Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
Normal Condition *
Diagnostic Note
Idling after warming up: CL
OL (Open Loop): Has not yet satisfied conditions to go closed
loop
CL (Closed Loop): Using heated
oxygen sensor(s) as feed back
for fuel control
OL DRIVE: Open loop due to
driving conditions (fuel enrichment)
OL FAULT: Open loop due to detected system fault
CL FAULT: Closed loop but one
of heated oxygen sensors, which
is used for fuel control, is malfunctioning
Fuel system status (Bank 2) /
OL or CL or OL DRIVE or
OL FAULT or CL FAULT
Idling after warming up: CL
OL (Open Loop): Has not yet satisfied conditions to go closed
loop
CL (Closed Loop): Using heated
oxygen sensor(s) as feed back
for fuel control
OL DRIVE: Open loop due to
driving conditions (fuel enrichment)
OL FAULT: Open loop due to detected system fault
CL FAULT: Closed loop but one
of heated oxygen sensors, which
is used for fuel control, is malfunctioning
Fuel cut idle/ ON or OFF
Fuel cut operation: ON
FC IDL = ON when throttle valve
is fully closed and engine speed is
over 1,500 rpm
MIL status/ ON or OFF
MIL ON: ON
Starter signal/ ON or OFF
Cranking: ON
A/C signal/ ON or OFF
A/C ON: ON
PNP switch signal/ ON or OFF
P or N position: ON
ELECT LOAD SIG
Electrical load signal/
ON or OFF
Taillamp switch ON: ON
Defogger switch ON: ON
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light switch/
ON or OFF
Brake pedal depressed: ON
Brake pedal released: OFF
Power steering oil pressure switch
signal/ ON or OFF
While turning the steering wheel:
ON
While not turning the steering
wheel: OFF
Idle-up control is performed when
PS is ON
Power steering signal/
ON or OFF
When steering wheel is turned
This signal is usually ON until the
Ignition switch is turned OFF
FUEL SYS #1
FUEL SYS #2
FC IDL
MIL
STARTER SIG
A/C SIG
PNP SW [NSW]
PS OIL PRESS SW
PS SIGNAL
Fuel system status (Bank 1) /
OL or CL or OL DRIVE or
OL FAULT or CL FAULT
INTAKE CTL VSV1
VSV status for intake control (bank
VSV operation: ON
1)/ ON or OFF
INTAKE CTL VSV 2
VSV status for intake control (bank
VSV operation: ON
2)/ ON or OFF
FUEL PUMP / SPD
Fuel pump/speed status/
ON/H or OFF/M, L
Idling: ON
A/C MAG CLUTCH
A/C magnet clutch status/
ON or OFF
A/C magnet clutch ON: ON
Author:
Date:
599
05-410
DIAGNOSTICS
Hand-held Tester Display
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition *
Diagnostic Note
EVAP VSV
VSV status for EVAP control/
ON or OFF
VSV operating: ON
BOOST PRESS VSV
VSV status for boost pressure
control/
ON or OFF
VSV operating: ON
Ignition counter/ Minimum: 0, Maximum: 600
0 to 600
Misfire ratio of cylinder 1 to 6/
Minimum: 0 %, Maximum: 50 %
0%
MISFIRE LOAD
Engine load for first misfire range/
Minimum: 0 g/rev, Maximum: 3.98
g/rev.
Misfire 0: 0 g/rev.
MISFIRE RPM
Engine RPM for first misfire range/
Minimum: 0 rpm, Maximum: 6,375
rpm
Misfire 0: 0 rpm
FC TAU
Fuel Cut TAU: Fuel cut during very
light load/ ON or OFF
Fuel cut operating: ON
Fuel cut is being performed under
very light load to prevent engine
combustion from becoming incomplete
Check mode/ ON or OFF
Check mode ON: ON
See step 3
IGNITION
CYL #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6
CHECK MODE
EVAP VSV is controlled by the
ECM (ground side duty control)
This item is displayed in only idling
HINT:
*: If no conditions are specifically stated for ”ldling”, the shift lever is in the N or P position, the A/C switch
is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
2.
ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the hand-held tester ACTIVE TEST allows relay, VSV, actuator and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to shorten
labor time. The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(e) Turn ON the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
(f)
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST.
(g) According to the display on tester, perform the ”ACTIVE TEST”.
Hand-held Tester Display
INJ VOL
A/F CONTROL
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
[Test Details]
Control injection volume
Minimum: -12.5 %, Maximum: 25 %
[Vehicle Condition]
Engine speed: 3,000 rpm or less
All injectors are tested at once
Injection volume is gradually
changed between -12.5 and 25
%
[Test Details]
Control injection volume
-12.5 or 25 % (change injection volume -12.5 % or 25 %)
[Vehicle Condition]
Engine speed: 3,000 rpm or less
Following A/F CONTROL procedure enables technician to check
and graph voltage outputs of both
the A/F sensor and heated oxygen
sensor
For displaying graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL /
USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1
and O2S B1S2” by pressing ”YES”
and push ”ENTER”. Then press
”F4”
Author:
Date:
600
05-41 1
DIAGNOSTICS
Hand-held Tester Display
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
[Test Details]
Activate VSV for intake control
ON or OFF
[Test Details]
Activate VSV for canister control
ON or OFF
EVAP VSV (ALONE)
[Test Details]
Activate EVAP VSV control
ON or OFF
A/C MAG CLUTCH
[Test Details]
Control A/C magnet clutch
ON or OFF
FUEL PUMP / SPD
[Test Details]
Control the fuel pump
ON or OFF
INTAKE CTL VSV1
CAN CTRL VSV
VVT CTRL B1
[Test Details]
Active VVT system (bank 1)
ON or OFF
ON: Rough idle or engine stall
OFF: Normal engine speed
VVT CTRL B2
[Test Details]
Active VVT system (bank 2)
ON or OFF
ON: Rough idle or engine stall
OFF: Normal engine speed
ACM INHIBIT
[Test Details]
Control ACM inhibit
ON or OFF
[Test Details]
Connect TC and TE1
ON or OFF
[Test Details]
Control idle fuel cut prohibit
ON or OFF
TC/TE1
FC IDL PROHBT
Author:
Date:
601
05-400
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EX7-05
DTC CHECK/CLEAR
NOTICE:
If no DTC appears in normal mode:
On the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester, check
the pending fault code using the Continuous Test Results function (Mode 7 for SAE J1979).
When the diagnosis system is changed from normal
mode to check mode or vice-versa, all DTCs and
freeze frame data recorded in normal mode will be
erased. Before changing modes, always check and
make a note of DTCs and freeze frame data.
Hand-held Tester
DLC3
A80020
1.
CHECK DTC (Using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held
tester)
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand-held tester to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Use the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to check
the DTCs and freeze frame data and then write them
down.
For the hand-held tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODEDS. For the OBD II scan tool, see its instruction manual.
(d) See page 05-412 to confirm the details of the DTCs.
NOTICE:
When simulating a symptom with the OBD II scan tool
(excluding hand-held tester) to check the DTCs, use
the normal mode. For DTCs subject to ”2 trip detection logic”, perform either of the following actions.
Turn the ignition switch OFF after the symptom is
simulated once. Then repeat the simulation process
again. When the problem has been simulated again,
the MIL illuminates and the DTCs are recorded in the
ECM.
Check the pending fault code using the Continuous
Test Results function (Mode 7 for SAE J1979) on the
OBD II scan tool.
2.
CLEAR DTC (Using the OBD II scan tool or hand-held
tester)
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or the hand-held tester to
the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
590
05-401
DIAGNOSTICS
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
(c)
Erase DTCs and freeze frame data with the OBD II scan
tool (complying with SAE J1978) or the hand-held tester
For the hand-held tester: 1) enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CLEAR
CODES; and 2) press YES. For the OBD II scan tool, see
its instruction manual.
3.
CLEAR DTC (Not using OBD II scan tool or hand-held
tester)
Remove the EFI NO. 1 fuse from the engine room J/B and
ETCS fuse from the engine room R/B No. 2 for more than
60 seconds, or disconnect the battery cable for more than
60 seconds.
After disconnecting the battery terminal, perform the ”INITIALIZE” procedure (see page 05-1005 ).
Engine Room J/B
(a)
EFI NO. 1
Engine Room R/B No. 2
-
ETCS
A87843
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
591
05-674
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXJ-05
ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned ON, battery voltage is applied to terminal IGSW of the ECM. The ECM
”MREL” output signal causes current to flow to the coil, closing the contacts of the EFI main relay (Marking:
EFI) and supplying power to terminal +B of the ECM.
If the ignition switch is turned OFF, the ECM holds the EFI main relay ON for a maximum of 2 seconds to
allow for the initial setting of the throttle valve.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
864
05-675
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
I15
Ignition Switch
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
1
1C
GR
7 AM2
IG2 6
IGN
Y
6
1G
10
IK2
W
Passenger Side J/B
W
4
4M
1
4E
J3
J/C
P
E
W
1 IC1
Engine Room J/B
P
E
9 IGSW
E5
W
2
E5 +B2
W
1
+B
E5
2B 4 EFI Relay
L-Y
3
1
5
2
5
2B
P-L
13
IK3
8
E5
B
MREL
1
E7 E1
EFI NO. 1
2I
1
4
2F
W
10
3
AM2
BR
F7
FL Block
Assy
W-B
1
W
A
A
J2
J/C
FL
Main
J7
J/C
A
BR
Battery
EH
ED
A94485
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
865
05-676
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT ECM (+B VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
(a)
(b)
+B (+)
E9
ECM
E5
ECM
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
OK
A67446
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-1 (+B) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN ON PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-393 )
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
E9
ECM
Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
E1
A81698
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-1 (E1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (IGSW VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
IGSW (+)
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-9 (IGSW) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
E5
ECM
A67446
OK
Go to step 6
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
866
05-677
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK FUSE (IGN)
(a)
(b)
Instrument
Panel J/B
Assy
Remove the IGN fuse from the instrument panel J/B assy.
Check the resistance of the IGN fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
IGN Fuse
A90344
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
5
INSPECT IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSY
(a)
IG1
AM1
ACC
I15
Ignition
Switch
ST2
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
AM2
ST1
IG2
A56879
Check the resistance of the switch terminals shown in the
chart below.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
LOCK
6 (IG2) - 7 (AM2)
10 kΩ or higher
START
6 (IG2) - 7 (AM2)
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSY
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BATTERY - IGNITION SWITCH, IGNITION
SWITCH - ECM)
6
INSPECT ECM (MREL VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
MREL (+)
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-8 (MREL) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
E5
ECM
A67446
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
867
05-678
DIAGNOSTICS
7
(a)
(b)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK FUSE (EFI NO. 1)
Remove the EFI NO. 1 fuse from the engine room J/B.
Check the resistance of the EFI NO. 1 fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
8
INSPECT RELAY (EFI)
1
3
(a)
(b)
2
5
5
2
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Check the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
1
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
9
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (EFI RELAY - ECM, EFI RELAY - BODY GROUND)
(a)
Engine Room J/B
EFI Relay
(b)
E5
ECM
Check the wire harness between the EFI relay and ECM.
(1) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
(2) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
J/B EFI relay terminal 1 - E5-8 (MREL)
Below 1 Ω
J/B EFI relay terminal 1 or E5-8 (MREL) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Check the wire harness between the EFI relay and body
ground.
(1) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
(2) Check the resistance between the wire harness
side connector and body ground.
Standard:
MREL
A90291
A67445
A92393
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
J/B EFI relay terminal 2 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TERMINAL +B OF ECM - BATTERY POSITIVE TERMINAL)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
868
05-679
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05MOT-01
EVAP INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When predetermined conditions (closed loop, etc.) are met, the EVAP VSV is opened and stored fuel vapor
in the canister is purged to the intake manifold. The ECM changes duty-cycle to the EVAP VSV to control
purge flow volume. Purge flow volume is determined by the intake manifold pressure. Atmospheric pressure
is allowed into the canister through the vent valve (CCV) to ensure that purge flow is maintained when negative pressure (vacuum) is applied to the canister. This EVAP system contains following components:
Components
Components
Operation
Canister
Contains activated charcoal to absorb EVAP that is created in fuel tank.
EVAP VSV
Opens or closes line between canister and intake manifold to control EVAP purge flow. EVAP VSV is
opened and purges fuel vapor absorbed by canister to intake manifold. ECM changes duty-cycle of
purge VSV to control purge volume (ON is open, OFF is closed).
Refueling Valve
Controls EVAP pressure from fuel tank to canister. Valve has diaphragm, spring and restrictor. When fuel
tank pressure increase, valve opens. When EVAP is purging, valve closes and restrictor prevents strong
of vacuum from affecting pressure in fuel tank. When valve opens, refueling is possible.
Service Port
Used for connecting vacuum gauge for inspecting EVAP system.
Vent Valve (CCV)
Vents and seals EVAP system. When CCV is turned ON, EVAP system is closed. When CCV is turned
OFF, EVAP system is vented. When vacuum introduction, EVAP VSV is opened and CCV is closed.
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Indicates pressure as voltage. 5 V is supplied by ECM. ECM detects EVAP system pressure using this
voltage.
Diagram
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
ECM
To Intake Manifold
Canister
EVAP VSV
EVAP Service Port
CCV (Vent Valve)
Canister Filter
A85820
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
869
05-680
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The EVAP monitor’s purpose is to check for EVAP leaks and EVAP VSV and CCV malfunctions. The monitor
performs the check by first introducing the intake manifold’s negative pressure (vacuum) to the EVAP system. Then, the monitor records change in the EVAP system’s pressure levels. The monitor runs when the
following conditions are met:
The engine coolant and intake air temperatures are 4 to 35C (40 to 90F).
The engine is idling or the vehicle is being driven at a steady speed.
The fuel tank pressure is stabilized.
LEVII EVAP Monitor Process
: Negative Pressure
1. Fuel Vapor Measurement
3. EVAP Leak Check
EVAP VSV: OFF (Closed)
EVAP VSV: OFF (Closed)
FTP Sensor
FTP Sensor
Fuel Tank
To Intake Manifold
CCV: ON (Closed)
Canister
Fuel Tank
To Intake Manifold
CCV: ON (Closed)
Canister
2. Vacuum Introduction
4. Restore
EVAP VSV: OFF (Closed)
EVAP VSV: ON (Open)
FTP Sensor
Fuel Tank
To Intake Manifold
CCV: ON (Closed)
Canister
FTP Sensor
Fuel Tank
To Intake Manifold
Canister
CCV: OFF (Open)
A96702
Sequence
Operation
Description
1
Fuel vapor measurement
EVAP VSV is turned OFF (closed) and EVAP pressure is measured. If
EVAP pressure is not stable, EVAP monitor is canceled to prevent inaccurate monitor.
2
Vacuum introduction
EVAP VSV is turned ON (open) and CCV is turned ON (closed). As a
result, intake manifold pressure (vacuum) is introduced to EVAP system.
3
EVAP leak check
EVAP VSV is turned OFF (closed) to seal EVAP system. EVAP pressure increase is measured for 5 seconds when EVAP pressure is -20
mmHg and -17 mmHg. If increase is large, ECM concludes EVAP system has leak.
4
Restore
CCV is turned OFF (open) to finish EVAP monitor.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
870
05-681
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
LEV II EVAP Monitor Sequence
Sequence
Step 1
CCV (Vent Valve)
ON
OFF
EVAP VSV
ON
OFF
Step 2
Step 3
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
CLOSE
OPEN
30 sec.
OPEN
15 sec.
30 sec.
300 sec.
Atmospheric
Pressure
(CCV Stuck Closed)
(Air Inlet Line Restriction)
(CCV Stuck Open)
(Medium Leak)
(Medium Leak)
(Small Leak)
(Large Leak)
(Purge Line Restriction)
(CCV Stuck Open)
(EVAP VSV Stuck Closed)
Normal Fuel Tank Pressure
A85206
Related DTCs
DTCs
Monitoring Item
P0441
EVAP VSV stuck closed
EVAP VSV stuck open
P0442
EVAP small leak (0.04 inch)
P0446
Vent valve (CCV) stuck closed
CCV stuck open
P0451
Fuel tank pressure (FTP) sensor malfunction
P0452
FTP sensor low output
P0453
FTP sensor high output
P0455
EVAP gross leak
P0456
EVAP small leak (0.02 inch)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
871
05-682
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
V11
Vapor Pressure Sensor
1
G-R
BI1
GND 1
3
BI1
BR
VCC 3
17
BR
BJ1
BR
PTNK 2
16
BJ1
L
2
BI1
B
15
BR
IO1
Y
12
BR
IM1
L
7
IO1
12
BJ1
Y
Short
Connector
5
5
BR
S28
S29
EFI NO. 2
2
1
Y
B-W
1
EB1
Y
3
IO1
Engine Room R/B No. 2
2
13
IM1
P
B-R
B-R
EFI Relay
1
5
1
34
PRG
E7
L
27 CCV
E7
2
14 IM1
IM1
GR
SB
5
16 IO1
5
IO1
R
V
2
PTNK
G
B-R
3
18
VC
E7
21
E5
L
Engine Room J/B
5
2B
28
E2
E7
V4
EVAP VSV
2
3 2D
ECM
P-L
EFI NO. 1
18 BJ1
V14
CCV
R
1
2I
4 2F
F7
FL Block
Assy
1
B
2
W
3
W-B
14 BJ1
1
13
IK3
B
8
E5
MREL
A
W
J2
J/C
Main
Battery
EH
A88695
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
872
05-683
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data. Freeze frame data records engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When
troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine
was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction
occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT
(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0441, P0442, P0446 AND/OR P0456)
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only P0441, P0442, P0446 and /or P0456 are output
A
P0451, P0452 and P453 are output
B
HINT:
If any other DTCs besides P0441, P0442, P0446 and/or P0456 are output, perform the troubleshooting for
those DTCs first (reference: P0451, P0452, P0453 are vapor pressure sensor malfunctions).
B
Go to RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-412 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
873
05-684
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK CURRENT AND PENDING DTC
(a)
Check current DTCs. Select the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED OBDII, DTC
INFO and CURRENT DTCS.
(b) Check pending DTCs. Select the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED OBDII, DTC
INFO and PENDING DTCS.
Result
Current DTC
Pending DTC
Set
Set
Set
-
-
Set
Conclusion
System has been malfunctioning. Problem can be specified.
System was malfunctioning in previous driving cycle. Problem may be specified.
System is malfunctioning. This is intermittent problem and caused by fuel tank cap loosening. Otherwise, this problem may be difficult to eliminate.
HINT:
The ECM stores the current DTC and illuminates the MIL when an emission-related component is malfunctioning in 2 consecutive driving cycles (2 trips). The MIL is turned OFF, if the component is functioning normally in 3 consecutive driving cycles. The ECM erases the current DTC, if the component is functioning normally in 40 consecutive driving cycles.
The ECM stores the pending DTC when If the component is malfunctioning in present driving cycle (1 trip).
The ECM erases the pending DTC, if the component is functioning normally in the next driving cycle.
NEXT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
874
05-685
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
PREDICT POSSIBLE MALFUNCTION AREA
Predict possible malfunction area using the matrix below.
EVAP DTC Matrix
DTCs
Malfunction Area
P0441
EVAP VSV stuck closed
EVAP VSV stuck open
P0442
P0446
P0451
P0452
P0453
P0455
P0456
EVAP small leak (0.04 inch)
CCV stuck closed
CCV stuck open
FTP sensor malfunction
FTP sensor low output
FTP sensor high output
Gross leak
EVAP small leak (0.02 inch)
DTCs
Suspected Malfunction Area
P0441 only
EVAP VSV stuck open
P0446 only
CCV (vent valve) stuck open
P0442 and/or P0456
Small leak
NEXT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
875
05-686
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
NOTICE:
The EVAP system check can be used for confirmation after the EVAP system repair. Check DTCs after
performing the EVAP system check. If no pending DTC is set, the EVAP system is functioning normally and the repair is complete.
(a) Select the ”mmHg” unit. Select the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, SETUP, UNIT CONVERSION and VAPOR PRESS.
(b) Allow the engine to idle.
(c) Perform the EVAP system check to find a malfunction area. Select the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED OBD ll, SYSTEM CHECK and LEV ll SYS CHECK.
(d) Read NOTICE and press ENTER.
HINT:
The EVAP system check is most accurate when the following conditions are being set:
Atmospheric pressure is 762 mmHg (sea level).
The engine coolant and intake air temperatures are 4 to 35C (40 to 90F).
The fuel tank level is 1/4 to 3/4.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
876
05-687
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Diagram of LEVII EVAP System Check
Sequence
Step 1
CCV (Vent Valve)
ON
OFF
EVAP VSV
ON
OFF
Step 2
Step 3
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
CLOSE
OPEN
30 sec.
OPEN
15 sec.
30 sec.
300 sec.
Atmospheric
Pressure
(CCV Stuck Closed)
(Air Inlet Line Restriction)
(CCV Stuck Open)
(Medium Leak)
(Medium Leak)
(Small Leak)
(Large Leak)
(Purge Line Restriction)
(CCV Stuck Open)
(EVAP VSV Stuck Closed)
Normal Fuel Tank Pressure
A85206
NEXT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
877
05-688
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK STEP 1 (INITIALIZE SYSTEM)
Step 1. Initialize System
EVAP Pressure Change during System Check
Sequence
EVAP VSV
EVAP VSV
Step 1
Close
FTP Sensor
CCV Open
To Intake
Manifold
Positive
VAPOR
PRESS
Fuel Tank
Negative
CCV (Vent Valve)
Canister
A97018
Wait for 30 seconds.
A96682
NEXT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
878
05-689
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK STEP 2 (CHECK FOR CCV)
Step 2. Check for CCV
EVAP VSV
To Intake
Manifold
EVAP Pressure Change during System Check
Sequence
Step 2
EVAP VSV
Open
CCV
Open
FTP Sensor
Normal
VAPOR
PRESS
Fuel Tank
Positive
Negative
CCV (Vent Valve)
Canister
CCV Stuck Closed
A97019
(a)
(b)
Press RIGHT to go to step 2.
Wait for 30 seconds and check VAPOR PRESS (EVAP
pressure).
A96683
Result
VAPOR PRESS
Conclusion
Proceed to
Higher than 752 mmHg-a (-10 mmHg-g)
Trouble area has not been found yet.
OK
Lower than 752 mmHg-a (-10 mmHg-g)
Following problems are suspected:
Air inlet line restriction
Canister filter restriction
CCV (vent valve) stuck closed
NG
HINT:
In this step, the intake manifold pressure (vacuum) is applied to the EVAP system. However, the fuel tank
pressure does not drop due to the CCV (vent valve) open.
NG
Go to step 11
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
879
05-690
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK STEP 3 (INITIALIZE SYSTEM)
Step 3. Initialize System
EVAP VSV
To Intake
Manifold
EVAP Pressure Change during System Check
FTP Sensor
Sequence
Step 3
EVAP VSV
Close
CCV
Open
Positive
Negative
VAPOR
PRESS
Fuel Tank
CCV (Vent Valve)
Canister
A97020
(a)
(b)
Press RIGHT to go to step 3.
Wait for 30 seconds.
A96684
NEXT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
880
05-691
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK STEP 4 (CHECK FOR EVAP VSV STUCK OPEN)
Step 4. Check for EVAP VSV
EVAP VSV
To Intake
Manifold
EVAP Pressure Change during System Check
Sequence
Step 4
EVAP VSV
Close
CCV
Close
FTP Sensor
Normal
VAPOR
PRESS
Fuel Tank
Positive
Negative
CCV (Vent Valve)
Canister
EVAP VSV Stuck Open
A97021
(a)
(b)
Press RIGHT to go to step 4.
Wait for 15 seconds and check VAPOR PRESS (EVAP
pressure).
A96685
Result
VAPOR PRESS
Conclusion
Proceed to
Higher than 758 mmHg-a (-4 mmHg-g)
Trouble area has not been found yet.
OK
Lower than 758 mmHg-a (-4 mmHg-g)
EVAP VSV stuck open
NG
NG
Go to step 14
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
881
05-692
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK STEP 5 (APPLYING VACUUM)
Step 5. Applying Vacuum
EVAP VSV
To Intake
Manifold
EVAP Pressure Change during System Check
Sequence
Step 5
EVAP VSV
Open
CCV
Close
FTP Sensor
Positive
Negative
VAPOR
PRESS
Fuel Tank
Fuel tank cap loosening
CCV (Vent Valve)
Gross leak
Purge line blockage
Canister
EVAP VSV stuck closed
CCV (vent valve) stuck closed
Normal
Medium Leak
A97022
(a)
(b)
Press RIGHT to go to step 5.
Wait for 30 seconds and check VAPOR PRESS (EVAP
pressure).
A96686
Result
VAPOR PRESS
Conclusion
Proceed to
Lower than 748 mmHg-a (-14 mmHg-g)
Trouble area has not been found yet.
A
756 to 768 mmHg-a (-6 to 6 mmHg-g)
Following problems are suspected:
Fuel tank cap loosening
Gross leak
EVAP VSV stuck closed
CCV (vent valve) stuck open
Purge line blockage between fuel tank and canister
B
748 to 755 mmHg-a (-14 to -7 mmHg-g)
Medium leak
C
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
882
05-693
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
NOTICE:
If the pressure is lower than 740 mmHg- a (- 22
mmHg-g), the hand-held tester closes the EVAP VSV.
A96687
If the pressure is lower than 735 mmHg- a (- 27
mmHg-g), the hand-held tester cancels the EVAP
system check.
A85481
B
Go to step 15
C
Go to step 18
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
883
05-694
DIAGNOSTICS
10
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
EVAP SYSTEM CHECK STEP 6 (LEAK CHECK FOR EVAP SYSTEM)
Step 6. Leak Check for EVAP System
EVAP Pressure Change during System Check
EVAP VSV
To Intake
Manifold
FTP Sensor
Sequence
Step 6
EVAP VSV
Close
CCV
Close
VAPOR
PRESS
Fuel Tank
Positive
Negative
Medium leak
CCV (Vent Valve)
Canister
Small Leak
Normal
A97023
(a)
(b)
Press RIGHT to go to step 6 when the VAPOR PRESS
(EVAP pressure) is lower than 742 mmHg-a (-20 mmHgg).
Wait for 300 seconds and check VAPOR PRESS (EVAP
pressure).
A96688
Result
VAPOR PRESS
Conclusion
Proceed to
Less than 758 mmHg-a (-4 mmHg-g)
EVAP system is functioning normally.
OK
Higher than 758 mmHg-a (-4 mmHg-g)
Leakage
NG
NG
Go to step 18
OK
Go to step 40
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
884
05-695
DIAGNOSTICS
11
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK CCV
CCV
(Vent Valve)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Canister
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Switch the CCV (vent valve) using the hand-held tester.
Select the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED OBD ll, ACTIVE TEST and CAN CTRL VSV.
Touch the CCV and check the operation during switching
the CCV.
A96691
Result
CCV (Vent Valve)
Conclusion
Proceed to
CCV is operated
CCV is functioning normally.
OK
CCV is not operated
CCV is malfunctioning.
NG
NG
Go to step 25
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
885
05-696
DIAGNOSTICS
12
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK AIR INLET LINE RESTRICTION
Canister
(a)
(b)
Canister Filter
CCV
Disconnect the air inlet line from the CCV.
Remove and reinstall the fuel tank cap to release the fuel
tank pressure.
Allow the engine to idle.
(c)
A96690
(d)
(e)
Perform step 2 of the EVAP system check.
Wait for 30 seconds and check VAPOR PRESS (EVAP
pressure).
A96683
Result
VAPOR PRESS
Conclusion
Proceed to
Higher than 752 mmHg-a (-10 mmHg-g)
Blockage in canister filter
A
Lower than 752 mmHg-a (-10 mmHg-g)
Blockage in CCV (vent valve) or canister
B
(f)
Reconnect the air inlet line to the CCV.
B
Go to step 13
A
REPLACE CANISTER FILTER
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
886
05-697
DIAGNOSTICS
13
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK CANISTER BLOCKAGE
Canister Filter
CCV
Canister
(a)
(b)
(c)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Remove the CCV from the canister.
Remove and reinstall the fuel tank cap to release the fuel
tank pressure.
Allow the engine to idle.
(d)
A96690
(e)
(f)
Perform step 2 of the EVAP system check.
Wait for 30 seconds and check VAPOR PRESS (EVAP
pressure).
A96683
Result
VAPOR PRESS
Conclusion
Proceed to
Higher than 752 mmHg-a (-10 mmHg-g)
CCV (vent valve) stuck closed
A
Lower than 752 mmHg-a (-10 mmHg-g)
Blockage in canister
B
B
CHECK AND REPLACE CHARCOAL CANISTER
(See page 12-28 )
A
REPLACE CCV (VENT VALVE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
887
05-698
DIAGNOSTICS
14
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK EVAP VSV (FOR EVAP VSV STUCK OPEN)
Engine : Idling
Disconnect
OK
Stuck Open
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Disconnect the purge hose of the canister from the EVAP
VSV.
Disconnect the EVAP VSV connector.
Allow the engine to idle.
Touch the EVAP VSV port to check the vacuum.
(c)
(d)
(e)
No Vacuum
Vacuum
A86478
Result
EVAP VSV
Conclusion
Proceed to
Vacuum is applied.
EVAP VSV is malfunctioning.
A
No vacuum is applied.
Electrical circuit of EVAP VSV is malfunctioning.
B
B
Go to step 29
A
REPLACE EVAP VSV
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
888
05-699
DIAGNOSTICS
15
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK FUEL TANK CAP
(a)
(b)
(c)
Remove the fuel tank cap and reinstall it until a few click sound is heard.
Clear the DTCs.
Check pending DTCs after the EVAP system check If no pending DTC is set, the DTC(s) was set due
to the fuel cap loosening.
If necessary, replace the fuel cap.
NG
Go to step 16
OK
REPAIR IS COMPLETE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
889
05-700
DIAGNOSTICS
16
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK EVAP VSV (FOR EVAP VSV STUCK CLOSED)
(a)
If EVAP VSV is functioning normally:
VSV is ON
Vacuum
VSV is OFF
No Vacuum
A86478
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the purge hose of the canister from the EVAP
VSV.
Allow the engine to idle.
Switch the EVAP VSV using the hand-held tester. Select
the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED
OBD ll, ACTIVE TEST and EVAP VSV.
Touch the EVAP VSV port to check the vacuum.
(d)
HINT:
The EVAP VSV can be tested with the EVAP Test Equipment
(go to step 39).
Result
EVAP VSV
Conclusion
Proceed to
Vacuum is applied when EVAP VSV is ON.
No vacuum is applied when EVAP VSV is OFF.
EVAP VSV is functioning normally.
OK
No vacuum is applied when EVAP VSV is ON.
Electrical circuit of EVAP VSV is malfunctioning.
NG
NG
Go to step 31
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
890
05-701
DIAGNOSTICS
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK CCV (FOR CCV STUCK OPEN)
CCV
(a)
(b)
(c)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Remove the CCV (vent valve) and plug the canister.
Allow the engine to idle.
(d)
Apply vacuum to the EVAP system with the EVAP system
check. Perform step 5 ”Applying Vacuum”.
Wait for 30 seconds and check the VAPOR PRESS
(EVAP pressure).
Canister
17
-
A96850
(e)
A96686
Result
VAPOR PRESS
Conclusion
Proceed to
Lower than 747 mmHg-a (-15 mmHg-g)
CCV (vent valve) stuck open
A
Higher than 747 mmHg-a (-15 mmHg-g)
Blockage in canister
Blockage in purge line (Fuel tank - Canister)
Blockage in purge line (Fuel tank -EVAP VSV)
B
B
Go to step 20
A
Go to step 24
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
891
05-702
DIAGNOSTICS
18
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK FUEL TANK CAP
(a)
(b)
(c)
Remove the fuel tank cap and reinstall it until a few click sound is heard.
Clear the DTCs.
Check pending DTCs after the EVAP system check If no pending DTC is set, the DTC(s) was set due
to the fuel cap loosening.
If necessary, replace the fuel cap.
NG
Go to step 19
OK
REPAIR IS COMPLETE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
892
05-703
DIAGNOSTICS
19
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK FILLER NECK DAMAGE
(a) Remove the fuel tank cap.
(b) Visually inspect the filler neck for damage.
(c) Reinstall the fuel tank cap.
HINT:
A leak point may be found with the EVAP Test Equipment (go
to step 36).
A96690
NG
REPLACE FUEL TANK INLET PIPE
OK
20
CHECK PURGE LINE (CANISTER - FUEL TANK)
(a)
(b)
(c)
A77160
Check that the pipes and hoses are connected correctly.
Check that the pipes and hoses are not loose or disconnected.
Check the pipes and hoses have no damage or blockage.
NG
REPLACE PURGE HOSE
OK
21
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK PURGE LINE (CANISTER - EVAP VSV)
Check that the pipes and hoses are connected correctly.
Check that the pipes and hoses are not loose or disconnected.
Check the pipes and hoses have no damage or blockage.
NG
REPLACE PURGE HOSE
OK
22
INSPECT CANISTER (See page 12-23 )
NG
REPLACE CANISTER
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
893
05-704
DIAGNOSTICS
23
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT FUEL TANK
Check that the fuel tank has no damage.
Check the fuel inlet pipe has no damage.
Check leakage from the fuel pump unit.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
DAMAGED PARTS
DEFFECTIVE
OR
OK
Go to step 40
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
894
05-705
DIAGNOSTICS
24
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK CCV
CCV
(Vent Valve)
(a)
(b)
Stop the engine and turn the ignition switch ON.
Switch the CCV (vent valve) using the hand-held tester.
Select the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED OBD ll, ACTIVE TEST and CAN CTRL VSV.
Touch the CCV and check the operation during switching
the CCV.
(c)
Canister
A96691
Result
CCV (Vent Valve)
Conclusion
Proceed to
CCV is operated
Electrical circuit of CCV is functioning normally.
A
CCV is not operated
Electrical circuit of CCV is malfunctioning.
B
B
Go to step 26
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
895
05-706
DIAGNOSTICS
25
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK CCV
If CCV (vent valve) is functioning normally:
CCV is ON (Close)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Remove the CCV (vent valve).
Connect the CCV connector,
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Switch the CCV using the hand-held tester. Select the
hand- held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED
OBD ll, ACTIVE TEST and CAN CTRL VSV.
Apply air to the CCV port using an air gun and check the
airflow.
No Airflow
(f)
Air
CCV is OFF (Open)
Airflow
Air
A85442
Result
CCV (Vent Valve)
Conclusion
Proceed to
Air flows when CCV is OFF (open).
Air does not flows when CCV is ON (close).
CCV is functioning normally.
Electrical circuit of CCV is malfunctioning.
A
Air flows when CCV is ON (close).
Air does not flows when CCV is OFF (open).
CCV is malfunctioning.
B
B
REPLACE CCV (See page 12-28 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
896
05-707
DIAGNOSTICS
26
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CCV - POWER SOURCE)
Wire Harness Side
Connector of CCV
Voltmeter
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Disconnect the CCV connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage between terminal 2 of the wire harness side connector and body ground.
A96694
Result
Voltage
Conclusion
Proceed to
Battery voltage
Wire harness (CCV - Power source) is OK.
OK
0 to 3 V
Wire harness (CCV - Power source) is short circuit.
NG
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
OK
27
CHECK WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CCV - ECM)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
Connector of CCV
Ohmmeter
(b)
Switch the CCV using the hand-held tester. Select the
hand- held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED
OBD ll, ACTIVE TEST and CAN CTRL VSV.
Measure the resistance between terminal 1 of the wire
harness side connector and body ground.
A96695
Result
Resistance
Conclusion
Proceed to
More than 10 kΩ when CCV is OFF.
Less than 10 Ω when CCV is ON.
ECM and wire harness (CCV - ECM) are OK.
CCV is malfunctioning.
OK
No change
Either of wire harness (CCV - ECM) or ECM is malfunctioning.
NG
NG
Go to step 28
OK
REPLACE CCV
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
897
05-708
DIAGNOSTICS
28
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CCV - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Check the wire harness between the ECM and CCV.
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance between the CCV and ECM wire
harness side connectors.
Standard
Wire Harness Side
Connector of CCV
Tester Connection
ECM
Specified Condition
1 (CCV) - E7-27 (ECM)
Less than 10 Ω
1 (CCV) - Body ground
More than 10 kΩ
E7-27
Y
A72890
A81699
A87759
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
898
05-709
DIAGNOSTICS
29
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK EVAP VSV
(a)
(b)
(c)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Switch the EVAP VSV using the hand-held tester. Select
the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED
OBD ll, ACTIVE TEST and EVAP VSV (Alone).
Listen to click sounds to check the EVAP VSV operation.
A96855
Result
EVAP VSV
Conclusion
Proceed to
Operated
Electrical circuit of EVAP VSV is functioning normally.
OK
Not operated
Electrical circuit of EVAP VSV is malfunctioning.
NG
NG
Go to step 32
OK
30
CHECK EVAP VSV
(a)
If EVAP VSV is functioning normally:
VSV is ON
Vacuum
VSV is OFF
No Vacuum
A86478
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the purge hose of the canister from the EVAP
VSV.
Start the engine.
Switch the EVAP VSV using the hand-held tester. Select
the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED
OBD ll, ACTIVE TEST and EVAP VSV.
Touch the EVAP VSV port to check the vacuum.
(d)
HINT:
The EVAP VSV can be tested with the EVAP Test Equipment
(go to step 39).
Result
EVAP VSV
Conclusion
Proceed to
Vacuum is applied when EVAP VSV is ON.
No vacuum is applied when EVAP VSV is OFF.
EVAP VSV is functioning normally.
OK
No vacuum is applied when EVAP VSV is ON.
Electrical circuit of EVAP VSV is malfunctioning.
NG
NG
Go to step 32
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
899
05-710
DIAGNOSTICS
31
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK PURGE LINE (EVAP VSV - THROTTLE BODY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
A96856
Check that the vacuum hoses are connected correctly.
Check that the vacuum hoses are not loose or disconnected.
Check the vacuum hoses and tubes for cracks, holes,
damage, or blockage.
NG
REPLACE PURGE HOSE
OK
REPLACE EVAP VSV
32
INSPECT EVAP VSV
26 to 30 Ω
(a) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the EVAP VSV connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the EVAP VSV.
Standard
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Between terminals
26 to 30 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
Each terminal - Body ground
10 kΩ or more
10 kΩ or more
A96698
NG
REPLACE EVAP VSV
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
900
05-71 1
DIAGNOSTICS
33
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT EVAP VSV
If EVAP VSV is functioning normally:
(a)
(b)
Remove the EVAP VSV.
Apply air to the EVAP VSV using an air gun, check the airflow.
(c)
(d)
Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
Apply air to the EVAP VSV using an air gun, check the airflow.
EVAP VSV is OFF
No Airflow
Air
A96920
If EVAP VSV is functioning normally:
EVAP VSV
is ON
Airflow
Air
Battery
A96700
Result
EVAP VSV
Conclusion
Proceed to
Air does not flow when EVAP VSV is OFF.
Air flows when EVAP VSV is ON.
EVAP VSV is functioning normally.
OK
Air flows when EVAP VSV is OFF.
Air does not flow when EVAP VSV is ON.
EVAP VSV is malfunctioning.
NG
NG
REPLACE EVAP VSV
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
901
05-712
DIAGNOSTICS
34
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (EVAP VSV - POWER SOURCE)
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
Connector of EVAP VSV
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage between the terminal 1 of the wire
harness side and body ground.
A96692
Result
Voltage
Conclusion
Proceed to
Battery voltage
Wire harness (EVAP VSV - Power source) is OK.
OK
0 to 3 V
Wire harness (EVAP VSV - Power source) is short circuit.
NG
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
35
CHECK WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (EVAP VSV - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
ECM
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage between the terminal 34 of the wire
harness side and body ground.
E7-34
A81699
Result
Voltage
Conclusion
Proceed to
Battery voltage
Wire harness (EVAP VSV - ECM) is OK.
OK
0 to 3 V
Wire harness (EVAP VSV - ECM) is short circuit.
NG
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
902
05-713
DIAGNOSTICS
36
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK FUEL TANK CAP
Connect the fuel tank cap to the gas cap adaptor.
Connect the pressure hose from the pump to the gas cap adaptor.
Plug the gas cap adaptor port.
Turn the pump ON and pressurize the gas cap adaptor by 24 - 28 mmHg. If the pressure does not
reach to 24 mmHg within 45 seconds, stop the pump. The fuel tank cap is malfunctioning.
Turn the pump OFF and seal the pressure line to maintain the pressure.
Measure the pressure change for 2 minutes. If the pressure drops to lower than 15 mmHg, the fuel
tank cap is malfunctioning.
Standard: The fuel tank cap keeps the pressure that is 15 mmHg or higher.
(e)
(f)
NG
REPLACE FUEL TANK CAP
OK
37
CHECK LEAK
NOTICE:
DO NOT apply the EVAP system to the pressure that is higher than 35 mmHg. The EVAP system will
be damaged.
(a) Connect the pressure line from the pump to the EVAP service port.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON but the engine is not running.
(c) Turn the CCV (vent valve) is ON (close) using the hand-held tester. Select the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED OBD ll, ACTIVE TEST and CAN CTRL VSV.
(d) Turn the pump ON and pressurize the EVAP system by 24 - 28 mmHg.
(e) Turn the pump OFF and seal the pressure line to maintain the pressure. If the pressure does not reach
to 24 mmHg within 45 seconds, stop the pump. A leakage is in the EVAP system. If the system has
a small leak, a whistling sound may be heard.
(f)
Measure the pressure change for 2 minutes. If the pressure drops to lower than 15 mmHg, a leakage
is in the EVAP system.
Standard: The EVAP system keeps the pressure that is 15 mmHg or higher.
NG
Go to step 38
OK
NO LEAKAGE IN EVAP SYSTEM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
903
05-714
DIAGNOSTICS
38
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
LOOK FOR LEAK POINT
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
A96922
(e)
(f)
(g)
Apply the soapy water on suspected components.
Turn the CCV (vent valve) is ON (close) using the handheld tester. Select the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS, ENHANCED OBD ll, ACTIVE TEST and CAN CTRL
VSV.
Turn the pump ON and pressurize the EVAP system by
24 - 28 mmHg.
Turn the pump OFF and seal the pressure line to maintain
the pressure. If the pressure does not reach to 24 mmHg
within 45 seconds, stop the pump.
Check bubbles to find the leak point:
EVAP service port
Canister
Hose connections/Lines
Fuel cap
Fuel filler neck
Purge line
EVAP VSV
CCV (vent valve)
Fuel pump sending unit
Repair or replace the leak component.
Perform the EVAP system check to confirm no leak.
NEXT
Go to step 4
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
904
05-715
DIAGNOSTICS
39
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK EVAP VSV
(a)
Vacuum Gauge
B06544
Connect the vacuum gauge to the EVAP service port.
(1) Start the engine.
(2) Switch the EVAP VSV using the hand-held tester.
Select the hand-held tester menus: DIAGNOSIS,
ENHANCED OBD ll, ACTIVE TEST and EVAP
VSV.
(3) Check the vacuum when switching the EVAP VSV.
If the vacuum gauge indicates negative value when
the EVAP VSV is ON, the EVAP VSV is functioning
normally.
OK:
The vacuum gauge indicates negative value when the
EVAP VSV is ON.
NG
Go to step 31
OK
Go to step 17
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
905
05-716
DIAGNOSTICS
40
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK MONITOR STATUS AND DTC
Clear DTCs.
Perform a drive pattern test (see page 05-387 ).
Check that the monitor result is PASS.
Confirm no pending DTC.
NEXT
REPAIR IS COMPLETE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
906
05-404
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EX9-05
FAIL-SAFE CHART
If any of the following codes are recorded, the ECM enters fail-safe mode.
DTC No.
Fail-Safe Operation
Fail-Safe Deactivation Conditions
P0031
P0032
P0037
P0038
P0051
P0052
P0057
P0058
Turn off heater
Ignition switch OFF
P0100
P0102
P0103
Ignition timing is calculated from engine RPM and TP
(Throttle Position)
”Pass” condition detected
P0110
P0112
P0113
IAT (Intake Air Temperature) is fixed at 20°C (68°F)
”Pass” condition detected
P0115
P0117
P0118
ECT (Engine Coolant Temperature) is fixed at 80°C (176°F)
”Pass” condition detected
P0120
P0121
P0122
P0123
P0220
P0222
P0223
P0604
P0606
P0607
P0657
P2102
P2103
P2111
P2112
P2118
P2119
P2135
If the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle control
motor. The throttle control valve returns to a predetermined
opening angle (approximately 16) by the force of the return
spring. The ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle
to enable the vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the
vehicle can be driven slowly. If the accelerator pedal is
depressed quickly, the vehicle may speed up and slow
down erratically.
”Pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is
turned OFF.
P0325
P0327
P0328
P0330
P0332
P0333
Maximum ignition timing retardation
Ignition switch OFF
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
594
05-405
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Fail-Safe Operation
Fail-Safe Deactivation Conditions
P0351
P0352
P0353
P0354
P0355
P0356
Fuel is cut
”Pass” condition detected
P2120
P2121
P2122
P2123
P2125
P2127
P2128
P2138
The accelerator pedal position sensor has two (main and
sub) sensor circuits. If a malfunction occurs in either of the
sensor circuits, the ECM detects the abnormal signal voltage difference between the two sensor circuits and
switches to limp mode. In limp mode, the functioning circuit
is used to calculate the accelerator pedal opening angle to
allow the vehicle to continue driving. If both circuits malfunction, the ECM regards the opening angle of the accelerator pedal to be fully closed. In this case, the throttle valve
will remain closed as if the engine is idling.
”Pass” condition is detected and the ignition switch is turned
OFF.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
595
05-717
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXK-05
FUEL PUMP CONTROL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the engine is cranked, current flows from the ignition switch terminal ST1 to the starter relay (Marking:
STARTER), and current flows to terminal STA of ECM (STA signal).
When the STA signal and NE signal are input to the ECM, Tr is turned ON, current flows to coil of the circuit
opening relay, the relay switches on, power is supplied to the fuel pump and the fuel pump operates.
While the NE signal is generated and the engine is running, the ECM keeps Tr ON (Circuit Opening relay
ON) and the fuel pump also keeps operating.
Circuit
Opening
Relay
EFI Relay
EFI NO. 1
Fuel Pump
ECM
FC
Ignition Switch
AM1
MREL
ST1
IGN
AM1
AM2
Tr
IG2
ST2
IGSW
PNP Switch
(STA Signal) STA
ALT
AM2
Main
S TAT E R
Relay
(NE Signal) NE
Battery
Starter
A85447
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
907
05-718
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
I15
Ignition Switch
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
1
1C
GR
7 AM2
IG2 6
Passenger Side J/B
6
1G
IGN
4
4M
W
ECM
1
4F
W
Y
R/B No.1
Engine Room J/B
1 IC1
1
2I
EFI NO. 1
1
EFI Relay
5
3
1
2
8
2B
W
2 IC2
1
B
5 2B
5
3
13
IK3
8
E5
B
MREL
3
AM2
10
FC
E5
1
4 2F
P-L
10
2
Y
Circuit Opening
Relay
L-Y
W
1
1
BR
F7
FL Block Assy
BR
W-B
1
1
E7 E1
8 IA2
W
A
A
J2
J/C
FL
Main
J7
J/C
L
A
4
F12
Fuel Pump
5
BR
W-B
Battery
EH
BC
ED
A88704
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
908
05-719
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Hand-held tester:
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER (OPERATE C/OPN RELAY)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / FUEL PUMP / SPD.
Check the relay operation while operating it with the hand-held tester.
Standard: Operating noise can be heard from the relay.
OK
Go to step 5
NG
2
INSPECT RELAY
1
3
(a)
(b)
2
5
5
2
Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B sub-assy.
Check the resistance of the circuit opening relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
1
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (FC VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
(a)
(b)
FC (+)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-10 (FC) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
E5
ECM
A67446
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
909
05-720
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY, CIRCUIT OPENING
RELAY - IGNITION)
(a)
E5
ECM
FC
R/B Sub-assy
Check the wire harness between the ECM and circuit
opening relay.
(1) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(2) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-10 (FC) - R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 2
Below 1 Ω
E5-10 (FC) or
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 2 -
10 kΩ or higher
Body ground
Circuit Opening
Relay
A67445
A92536
A92536
(b)
Wire Harness Side
R/B Sub-assy
Circuit Opening
Relay
I15
Ignition Switch
1
5
A90342
A85676
IG2
2
6
3
7
4
8
A92537
Check the wire harness between the circuit opening relay
and ignition switch.
(1) Check the IGN fuse.
Remove the IGN fuse from the instrument
panel J/B assy.
Check the resistance of the IGN fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
Reinstall the IGN fuse.
(2) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(3) Disconnect the I15 ignition switch connector.
(4) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 1 - I15-6
Below 1 Ω
I15-6 or R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 1 Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
910
05-721
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT FUEL PUMP ASSY
(a)
3 2 1
5
4
F12
Fuel Pump
A74356
Check the fuel pump resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between terminals 4 and 5.
Standard: 0.2 to 3.0 Ω at 20C (68F)
(b) Check the fuel pump operation
(1) Apply battery voltage to both the terminals. Check
that the pump operates.
NOTICE:
These tests must be done quickly (within 10 seconds)
to prevent the coil from burning out.
Keep fuel pump as far away from the battery as possible.
Always turn on and off the voltage on the battery side,
not the fuel pump side.
NG
REPLACE FUEL PUMP ASSY
(See page 11-55 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
911
05-722
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY - FUEL PUMP, FUEL PUMP BODY GROUND)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
R/B Sub-assy
Circuit Opening
Relay
F12
Fuel Pump
A90342
A85674
Check the wire harness between the circuit opening relay
and fuel pump.
(1) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(2) Disconnect the F12 fuel pump connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 3 - F12-4
Below 1 Ω
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 3 or F12-4 Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A92538
(b)
Wire Harness Side
F12
Fuel Pump
A67586
Check the wire harness between the fuel pump and body
ground.
(1) Disconnect the F12 fuel pump connector.
(2) Check the resistance the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F12-5 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
CHECK FUEL PUMP OPERATION (See page 11-38 )
(a) Check if there is pressure in the fuel inlet hose.
HINT:
The pipe has fuel pressure if the sound of flowing fuel can be heard.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN ON PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(See page 05-393 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
912
05-723
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK RELAY OPERATION (OPERATION)
(a)
E5
ECM
When connecting between terminal FC of the E5 ECM
connector and the body ground, check the relay operation.
OK:
Noise can be heard from the circuit opening relay.
FC
OK
A53765
Go to step 6
NG
3
INSPECT RELAY
1
3
(a)
(b)
2
5
5
2
Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B sub-assy.
Check the resistance of the circuit opening relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
1
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
4
INSPECT ECM (FC VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
(a)
(b)
FC (+)
E5
ECM
A67446
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-10 (FC) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
913
05-724
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY, CIRCUIT OPENING
RELAY - IGNITION)
(a)
E5
ECM
FC
R/B Sub-assy
Check the wire harness between the ECM and circuit
opening relay.
(1) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(2) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-10 (FC) - R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 2
Below 1 Ω
E5-10 (FC) or
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 2 -
10 kΩ or higher
Body ground
Circuit Opening
Relay
A67445
A92536
A92536
(b)
Wire Harness Side
R/B Sub-assy
Circuit Opening
Relay
I15
Ignition Switch
1
5
A90342
A85676
IG2
2
6
3
7
4
8
A92537
Check the wire harness between the circuit opening relay
and ignition switch.
(1) Check the IGN fuse.
Remove the IGN fuse from the instrument
panel J/B assy.
Check the resistance of the IGN fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
Reinstall the IGN fuse.
(2) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(3) Disconnect the I15 ignition switch connector.
(4) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 1 - I15-6
Below 1 Ω
I15-6 or R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 1 Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
914
05-725
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT FUEL PUMP ASSY
(a)
3 2 1
5
4
F12
Fuel Pump
A74356
Check fuel pump resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between terminals 4 and 5.
Standard: 0.2 to 3.0 Ω at 20C (68F)
(b) Check fuel pump operation
(1) Apply battery voltage to both the terminals. Check
that the pump operates.
NOTICE:
These tests must be done quickly (within 10 seconds)
to prevent the coil from burning out.
Keep fuel pump as far away from the battery as possible.
Always turn on and off the voltage on the battery side,
not the fuel pump side.
NG
REPLACE FUEL PUMP ASSY
(See page 11-55 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
915
05-726
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY - FUEL PUMP, FUEL PUMP BODY GROUND)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
R/B Sub-assy
Circuit Opening
Relay
F12
Fuel Pump
A90342
A85674
Check the wire harness between the circuit opening relay
and fuel pump.
(1) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(2) Disconnect the F12 fuel pump connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 3 - F12-4
Below 1 Ω
R/B sub-assy circuit opening relay terminal 3 or F12-4 Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A92538
(b)
Wire Harness Side
F12
Fuel Pump
A67586
Check the wire harness between the fuel pump and body
ground.
(1) Disconnect the F12 fuel pump connector.
(2) Check the resistance the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F12-5 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
916
05-377
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05IQH-02
LIST OF DISABLE A MONITOR
HINT:
The table below shows the ECM monitoring status for the components listed in the top of the table when
the DTCs on the left of the table are set.
A92385
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
567
05-378
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
A92386
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
568
05-379
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
A92387
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
569
05-380
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
A92388
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
570
05-381
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
A92389
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
571
05-382
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
A92390
Note *1: Without input speed sensor
Note *2: With input speed sensor
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
572
05-727
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
059UT-36
MIL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) is used to indicate the ECM’s detection of a vehicle malfunction.
The instrument panel GAUGE fuse provides circuit power and the ECM provides the circuit ground that illuminates the MIL.
MIL operations should be checked visually:
The MIL should be illuminated when the ignition is first turned on. If the MIL is always ON or OFF, use the
hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool and follow the procedures below to determine the cause of the problem.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Combination Meter
9
IL1
SB
13
C11
4
C12
MIL
L
10
IL2
SB
11
E5 W
P
J3
J/C
Passenger Side J/B
P
E
E
1
4E
4
4M
L-Y
1 AM2
W
6
1G
IGN
1
1C
I15
Ignition Switch
F7
FL Block Assy
W
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
10
1
IC1
GR
Y
7 AM2 IG2 6
FL
Main
Battery
G38127
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Troubleshoot each trouble symptom in accordance with the chart below.
MIL remains on
Start inspection from step 1
MIL is not illuminated
Start inspection from step 3
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
917
05-728
DIAGNOSTICS
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CLEAR DTC
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC 3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
Read the DTC (See page 05-400 ).
Clear the DTC (See page 05-400 ).
Check that MIL is not illuminated.
OK: MIL is not illuminated
OK
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT DTC
(See page 05-412 )
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CHECK FOR SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
E5
ECM
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check that MIL is not illuminated.
OK: MIL is not illuminated
Reconnect the ECM connector.
W
A67445
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
3
(a)
CHECK THAT MIL IS ILLUMINATED
Check that the MIL is illuminated when turning the ignition switch ON.
OK: MIL is illuminated
OK
SYSTEM OK
NG
4
(a)
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ASSY (MIL CIRCUIT)
See the combination meter troubleshooting on page 05-1882 .
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE BULB OR COMBINATION
METER ASSEMBLY
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - ECM)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
918
05-383
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05F0A-05
O2S TEST RESULT
1.
INTRODUCTION
The O2S TEST RESULT refers to the results of the Engine Control Module (ECM) when it monitors the oxygen sensor (O2S),
and it can be read using the hand-held tester or the generic
OBD II scan tool. Based on this, you can find the O2S’s conditions.
The ECM monitors the O2S for the various data. You can read
the monitor result (TEST DATA) of each monitor item using the
O2S TEST RESULT. However, the output value of the TEST
DATA is the latest ”snapshot” value that is it taken after monitoring and therefore it is not dynamic.
In this repair manual, the description of the O2S TEST RESULT
(for O2S related DTCs) are written in a table.
This table consists of 5 items:
(1) TEST ID (a code applied to each TEST DATA)
(2) Description of TEST DATA
(3) Conversion Factor (When conversion factor has a
value written in the table, multiply the TEST DATA
value appearing on the scan tool by the conversion
factor value. The result will be the required value.)
(4) Unit
(5) Standard Value
If the TEST DATA value appearing on the scan tool is out of the
standard value, the O2S is malfunctioning. If it is within the standard value, the O2S is functioning normally. However, if the value is on the borderline of the standard value, the O2S may malfunction very soon.
2.
HOW TO READ O2S TEST RESULT USING HANDHELD TESTER
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b)
O2S TEST RESULT Screen
01 BANK 1 - SENSOR 1
On the tester screen, select the following menus: DIAGNOSIS/CARB OBDII/O2S TEST RESULT. A list of the
O2S equipped on the vehicle will be displayed.
01 BANK 1 - SENSOR 2
01 BANK 2 - SENSOR 1
01 BANK 2 - SENSOR 2
A88567
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
573
05-384
DIAGNOSTICS
(c)
TEST DATA Screen
LOW SW V ⋅ ⋅ ⋅
HIGH SW V ⋅ ⋅ ⋅
MIN O2S V ⋅ ⋅ ⋅
MAX O2S V ⋅ ⋅ ⋅
TIME $81 ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅
(d)
0.400 V
0.550 V
0.100 V
0.900 V
17
(e)
A88568
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Select the desired O2S and press ENTER. The following
screen will appear.
Press HELP and simultaneously. More information will
appear.
Example:
(1) The hand-held tester displays ”17” as a value of the
”TIME $81” (see the illustration on the left).
(2) Find the conversion factor value of ”TIME $81” in
the O2S TEST RESULT chart below. 0.3906 is specified for $81 in this chart.
(3) Multiply ”17” in step (1) by 0.3906 (conversion factor) in the step (2).
17 x 0.3906 = 6.6 %
(4) If the answer is within the standard value, the ”TIME
$81” can be confirmed to be normal.
O2S TEST RESULT Chart
TEST ID
$81
Description of TEST DATA
Percentage of monitoring
time when the O2S voltage
is less than 0.05V
Conversion Factor
Multiply 0.3906
Unit
%
Standard Value
Within 60%
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
574
05-422
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
05EXB-05
DTC
P0010
CAMSHAFT POSITION ”A” ACTUATOR
CIRCUIT (BANK 1)
DTC
P0020
CAMSHAFT POSITION ”A” ACTUATOR
CIRCUIT (BANK 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system includes the ECM, the Oil Control Valve (OCV) and the VVT controller. The ECM sends a target duty-cycle control signal to the OCV. This control signal, sent to the OCV, regulates the oil pressure applied to the VVT controller. Camshaft timing control is performed based on engine
operation conditions such as intake air volume, throttle position and engine coolant temperature.
The ECM controls the OCV based on the signals output from several sensors. The VVT controller regulates
the intake camshaft angle using oil pressure through the OCV. As a result, the relative position between the
camshaft and the crankshaft is optimized. Also, the engine torque and, fuel economy improve, and exhaust
emissions decrease. The ECM detects the actual valve timing using signals from the camshaft position sensor and the crankshaft position sensor. The ECM performs feedback control and verifies target valve timing.
ECM
Crankshaft Position Sensor
MAF Meter
OCV
Target Valve Timing
Throttle Position Sensor
Feedback
Duty Control
ECT Sensor
Correction
Vehicle Speed Signal
Camshaft Position Sensor
Actual Valve Timing
A71007
DTC No.
P0010
P0020
DTC Detection Condition
Open or short in OCV circuit
Trouble Area
Open or short in OCV circuit
OCV
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
After the ECM sends the ”target” duty-cycle signal to the OCV, the ECM monitors the OCV current to establish an ”actual” duty-cycle. When the actual duty-cycle ratio varies from the target duty-cycle ratio, the ECM
sets a DTC.
Author:
Date:
612
05-423
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0010: VVT OCV (Bank 1) Range Check
P0020: VVT OCV (Bank 2) Range Check
Required sensors / components (Main)
VVT OCV
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
1 second
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Target duty ratio for the OCV
70 % or less
Starter
OFF
Current cut status for the OCV
Not cut
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. OCV duty ratio
100 % (always ON) despite the target duty ratio is less than 70 %
2. OCV duty ratio when ECM supplies current to OCV
3 % or less despite the ECM supplying the current to the OCV
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VVT OCV duty ratio
3 to 100 %
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
C4
OCV (Bank 1)
1
G-W
16
OC1+
E9
2
G-R
15
OC1E9
1
L-R
14
OC2+
E9
2
G-B
13
OC2E9
C3
OCV (Bank 2)
A86808
Author:
Date:
613
05-424
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P0010 is displayed, check the bank 1 VVT system circuit.
If DTC P0020 is displayed, check the bank 2 VVT system circuit.
Read freeze frame data using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Hand-held tester:
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER (OCV OPERATION)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine and warm it up.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VVT CTRL B1 or VVT
CTRL B2.
Using the hand-held tester, operate the OCV and check the engine speed.
Standard:
(e)
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
OCV is OFF
Normal engine speed
OCV is ON
Rough idle or engine stall
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
NG
2
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
(See page 10-13 )
OK: OCV has no contamination and moves smoothly.
NG
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL
VALVE ASSY
OK
Author:
Date:
614
05-425
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
CHECK ECM (OCV SIGNAL)
(a)
E9
ECM
OC1 +
OC1-
OC2 +
During idling, check the waveform of the ECM connector
using the oscilloscope.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-16 (OC1+) - E9-15 (OC1-)
E9-14 (OC2+) - E9-13 (OC2-)
Correct waveform is as shown
OC2-
OCV Signal Waveform
5 V/
Division
GND
1 msec./Division
A87357
A67528
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (OCV-ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
C4 (Bank 1)
C3 (Bank 2)
OCV
Disconnect the C4 or C3 OCV connector.
Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
C4-1
C4-2
C3-1
C3-2
C4-1
C4-2
C3-1
C3-2
E9
ECM
Y
A54386
A81698
OC1+
OC2-
OC1-
OC2+
A85431
NG
(OCV) (OCV) (OCV) (OCV) -
Specified Condition
E9-16 (OC1+)
E9-15 (OC1-)
E9-14 (OC2+)
E9-13 (OC2-)
(OCV) or E9-16 (OC1+) - Body
(OCV) or E9-15 (OC1-) - Body
(OCV) or E9-14 (OC2+) - Body
(OCV) or E9-13 (OC2-) - Body
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
Below 1 Ω
ground
ground
ground
ground
REPLACE
10 kΩ or higher
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS (See page 05-370 )
Author:
Date:
615
05-426
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY (OCV OPERATION)
Wire Harness Side
(a)
(b)
C4 (Bank 1)
C3 (Bank 2)
OCV
(c)
Disconnect the C4 or C3 OCV connector.
Apply positive battery voltage between the terminals of
the OCV.
Check the engine speed.
OK:
Engine speed is rough idle or engine is stalled.
NG
A54386
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL
VALVE ASSY
OK
2
CHECK ECM (OCV SIGNAL)
(a)
E9
ECM
OC1 +
OC1-
OC2 +
During idling, check the waveform of the E9 ECM connector using the oscilloscope.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-16 (OC1+) - E9-15 (OC1-)
E9-14 (OC2+) - E9-13 (OC2-)
Correct waveform is as shown
OC2-
OCV Signal Waveform
5 V/
Division
GND
1 msec./Division
A67528
A87357
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
Author:
Date:
616
05-427
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)(From August, 2004)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (OCV-ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
C4 (Bank 1)
C3 (Bank 2)
OCV
Disconnect the C4 or C3 OCV connector.
Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
C4-1
C4-2
C3-1
C3-2
C4-1
C4-2
C3-1
C3-2
E9
ECM
Y
A54386
A81698
OC1+
OC2-
OC1-
OC2+
A85431
NG
(OCV) (OCV) (OCV) (OCV) -
Specified Condition
E9-16 (OC1+)
E9-15 (OC1-)
E9-14 (OC2+)
E9-13 (OC2-)
(OCV) or E9-16 (OC1+) - Body
(OCV) or E9-15 (OC1-) - Body
(OCV) or E9-14 (OC2+) - Body
(OCV) or E9-13 (OC2-) - Body
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
Below 1 Ω
ground
ground
ground
ground
REPLACE
10 kΩ or higher
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS (See page 05-370 )
Author:
Date:
617
05-428
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05AII-22
DTC
P0011
CAMSHAFT POSITION ”A” -TIMING OVERADVANCED OR SYSTEM PERFORMANCE
(BANK 1)
DTC
P0012
CAMSHAFT POSITION ”A” -TIMING OVERRETARDED (BANK 1)
DTC
P0021
CAMSHAFT POSITION ”A” - TIMING
OVER-ADV ANCED OR SYSTEM
PERFORMANCE (BANK 2)
DTC
P0022
CAMSHAFT POSITION ”A” - TIMING
OVER-RET ARDED (BANK2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0010 on page 05-422
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0011
P0021
After engine is warmed up and engine speed is at 500 to
4,000 rpm, condition (a) continues (1 trip detection logic)
(e) Valve timing does not change from current valve timing
(Problem of advanced valve timing)
Valve timing
OCV
Camshaft timing gear assy
ECM
P0012
P0022
After engine is warmed up and engine speed is at 500 to
4,000 rpm, condition (a) continues (2 trip detection logic)
(a) Valve timing does not change from current valve timing
(Problem of retarded valve timing)
Valve timing
OCV
Camshaft timing gear assy
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM optimizes the valve timing using the Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system to control the intake valve
camshaft. The VVT system includes the ECM, the Oil Control Valve (OCV) and the VVT controller. The ECM
sends a target duty-cycle control signal to the OCV. This control signal, sent to the OCV, regulates the oil
pressure applied to the VVT controller. The VVT controller can advance or retard the intake valve camshaft.
Example:
A DTC will be set if: 1) the difference between the ”target” and ”actual” valve timing is more than 5 degrees
of the camshaft angle (CA) and the condition continues for more than 4.5 seconds; or 2) the OCV is forcibly
activated 63 times or more.
Advanced cam DTCs are subject to ”1 trip” detection logic.
Retarded cam DTCs are subject to ”2 trip” detection logic.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
618
05-429
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0011: Advanced Camshaft Timing (Bank 1)
P0012: Retarded Camshaft Timing (Bank 1)
P0021: Advanced Camshaft Timing (Bank 2)
P0022: Retarded Camshaft Timing (Bank 2)
Required sensors / components (Main)
VVT OCV and VVT Actuators
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP, CMP and ECT sensors
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 10 seconds
MIL operation
P0011 and P0021: Immediate
P0012 and P0022: 2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Engine RPM
500 to 4,000 rpm
ECT
75 to 100C (167 to 212F)
Throttle position learning
Completed
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Deviation of valve timing
More than 5CA (Crankshaft Angle)
OCV activation
63 times or more
Response of valve timing
1 second/CA or more (valve timing does not change)
If the difference between ”target” and ”actual”camshaft timing is larger than the specified value, the ECM
operates the VVT actuator.
The ECM then monitors the camshaft timing change for 5 seconds.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0010 on page 05-422 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Abnormal bank
Problem of advanced OCV
Problem of retarded OCV
Bank 1
P0011
P0012
Bank 2
P0021
P0022
If DTC P0011 and/or P0012 is displayed, check the right bank VVT system.
If DTC P0021 and/or P0022 is displayed, check the left bank VVT system.
Read freeze frame data using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
619
05-430
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Hand-held tester:
1
CHECK VALVE TIMING (CHECK FOR LOOSE OR JUMPED TOOTH OF TIMING
BELT) (See page 14-206 )
OK: The matchmarks of crankshaft pulley and camshaft pulley are aligning.
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING (See page 14-206 )
OK
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER (OCV OPERATION)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine and warm it up.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VVT CTRL B1 or VVT
CTRL B2.
Using the hand-held tester, operate the OCV and check the engine speed.
Standard:
(e)
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
OCV is OFF
Normal engine speed
OCV is ON
Rough idle or engine stall
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
(a)
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUTS REOCCUR
Clear the DTCs.
(1) Erase the codes using one of the following methods: 1) use the hand held tester, 2) disconnect
the battery cable, or 3) remove the EFI NO. 1 and ETCS fuses for more than 60 seconds.
HINT:
After disconnecting the battery cable, perform the ”INITIALIZE” procedure (see page 05-1005 ).
(b) Start and warm up the engine.
(c) Drive the vehicle for 10 minutes or more.
(d) Read output DTC using the hand-held tester.
OK: No DTC output.
OK
VVT SYSTEM OK*
HINT:
*: DTC P0011, P0012, P0021 or P0022 is output when a foreign
object in the engine oil enters the system. These codes will stay
registered even if the system returns to normal after a short
time. Foreign objects are filtered out by the oil filter.
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
620
05-431
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK ECM (OCV SIGNAL)
(a)
E9
ECM
OC1 +
OC1-
OC2 +
During idling, check the waveform of the ECM connector
using the oscilloscope.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-16 (OC1+) - E9-15 (OC1-)
E9-14 (OC2+) - E9-13 (OC2-)
Correct waveform is as shown
OC2-
OCV Signal Waveform
5 V/
Division
GND
1 msec./Division
A87357
A67528
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
5
CHECK OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
OK: The filter is not clogged.
NG
REPLACE OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
OK
6
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
(See page 10-13 )
OK: OCV has no contamination and moves smoothly.
OK
Go to step 8
NG
7
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
621
05-432
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY (See page 14-213 or 14-224 )
OK: Camshaft timing gear rotate smoothly when apply pressure.
OK
Go to step 10
NG
9
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
GO
10
CHECK FOR BLOCKAGE (OCV, OIL CHECK VALVE AND OIL HOLE)
OK: No blockage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
OK
11
(a)
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUTS REOCCUR
Clear the DTCs.
(1) Erase the codes using one of the following methods: 1) use the hand held tester, 2) disconnect
the battery cable, or 3) remove the EFI NO. 1 and ETCS fuses for more than 60 seconds.
HINT:
After disconnecting the battery cable, perform the ”INITIALIZE” procedure (see page 05-1005 ).
(b) Start and warm up the engine.
(c) Drive the vehicle around for 10 minutes or more.
(d) Read output DTC using the hand-held tester.
OK: No DTC output.
OK
VVT SYSTEM OK*
HINT:
*: DTC P0011, P0012, P0021 or P0022 is output when a foreign
object in the engine oil enters the system. These codes will stay
registered even if the system returns to normal after a short
time. Foreign objects are filtered out by the oil filter.
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
622
05-433
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
CHECK VALVE TIMING (CHECK FOR LOOSE OR JUMPED TOOTH OF TIMING
BELT) (See page 14-206 )
OK: The matchmarks of crankshaft pulley and camshaft pulley are aligning.
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING (See page 14-206 )
OK
2
INSPECT OPERATION OF OCV
(a)
(b)
C4 (Bank 1)
C3 (Bank 2)
OCV
(-)
Start the engine.
Check the engine speed with (1) and (2).
(1) Disconnect the C4 or C3 OCV connector.
(2) Apply battery positive voltage between the terminals of the OCV.
Result:
Proceed to
Check (1)
Check (2)
A
Normal engine speed
Rough idle or engine stall
B
Conditions other than A
Conditions other than A
(+)
A76968
B
Go to step 4
A
3
(a)
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUTS REOCCUR
Clear the DTCs.
(1) Erase the codes using one of the following methods: 1) use the hand held tester, 2) disconnect
the battery cable, or 3) remove the EFI NO. 1 and ETCS fuses for more than 60 seconds.
HINT:
After disconnecting the battery cable, perform the ”INITIALIZE” procedure (see page 05-1005 ).
(b) Start and warm up the engine.
(c) Drive the vehicle around for 10 minutes or more.
(d) Read output DTC using the OBD II scan tool.
OK: No DTC output.
OK
VVT SYSTEM OK*
HINT:
*: DTCs P0011, P0012, P0021 or P0022 is output when a foreign object in the engine oil enters the system. These codes will
stay registered even if the system returns to normal after a short
time. Foreign objects are filtered out by the oil filter.
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
623
05-434
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK ECM (OCV SIGNAL)
(a)
E9
ECM
OC1 +
OC1-
OC2 +
During idling, check the waveform of the ECM connector
using the oscilloscope.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-16 (OC1+) - E9-15 (OC1-)
E9-14 (OC2+) - E9-13 (OC2-)
Correct waveform is as shown
OC2-
OCV Signal Waveform
5 V/
Division
GND
1 msec./Division
A87357
A67528
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
5
CHECK OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
OK: The filter is not clogged.
NG
REPLACE OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
OK
6
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
(See page 10-13 )
OK: OCV has no contamination and moves smoothly.
OK
Go to step 8
NG
7
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
624
05-435
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY (See page 14-213 or 14-224 )
OK: Camshaft timing gear rotate smoothly when apply pressure.
OK
Go to step 10
NG
9
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
GO
10
CHECK FOR BLOCKAGE (OCV, OIL CHECK VALVE AND OIL HOLE)
OK: No blockage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
OK
11
(a)
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUTS REOCCUR
Clear the DTCs.
(1) Erase the codes using one of the following methods: 1) use the hand held tester, 2) disconnect
the battery cable, or 3) remove the EFI NO. 1 and ETCS fuses for more than 60 seconds.
HINT:
After disconnecting the battery cable, perform the ”INITIALIZE” procedure (see page 05-1005 ).
(b) Start and warm up the engine.
(c) Drive the vehicle around for 10 minutes or more.
(d) Read output DTC using the OBD II scan tool.
OK: No DTC output.
OK
VVT SYSTEM OK*
HINT:
*: DTCs P0011, P0012, P0021 or P0022 is output when a foreign object in the engine oil enters the system. These codes will
stay registered even if the system returns to normal after a short
time. Foreign objects are filtered out by the oil filter.
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
625
05-436
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05FFD-06
DTC
P0016
CRANKSHAFT POSITION - CAMSHAFT
POSITION CORRELATION (BANK 1 SENSOR
A)
DTC
P0018
CRANKSHAFT POSITION - CAMSHAFT
POSITION CORRELATION (BANK 2 SENSOR
A)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTCs P0335 and P0339 on page 05-532 .
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0016
Deviation in crankshaft position sensor signal and VVT sensor
1 signal (2 trip detection logic)
Mechanical system (timing belt has jumped tooth, belt
stretched)
ECM
P0018
Deviation in crankshaft position sensor signal and VVT sensor
2 signal (2 trip detection logic)
Mechanical system (timing belt has jumped tooth, belt
stretched)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM optimizes the valve timing using the Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system to control the intake valve
camshaft. The VVT system includes the ECM, the Oil Control Valve (OCV) and the VVT controller. The ECM
sends a target duty-cycle control signal to the OCV. This control signal, sent to the OCV, regulates the oil
pressure applied to the VVT controller. The VVT controller can advance or retard the intake valve camshaft.
The ECM calibrates the valve timing of the VVT system by setting the camshaft to the maximum retard angle
when the engine is idling. The ECM closes the OCV to retard the cam. The ECM stores this value as a VVT
learning value. When the difference between the target valve timing and the actual valve timing is 5 degrees
or less, the ECM stores this in its memory.
If the learning value meets both of the following conditions (”a” and ”b”), the ECM interprets this as a defect
in the VVT system and sets a DTC.
(a) The VVT learning value is less than 21CA (Bank 1)/22CA (Bank 2) or more than 46CA (Bank
1)/40CA (Bank 2).
(b) The above condition continues for more than 18 seconds.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0016: Camshaft Timing (Bank 1) Misalignment at Idling
P0018: Camshaft Timing (Bank 2) Misalignment at Idling
Required sensors / components (Main)
VVT actuator
Required sensors / components (Related)
CMP and CKP sensors
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 60 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-377
Engine RPM
500 to 1,400 rpm
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
626
05-437
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Duration that either of the following conditions 1 or 2 is met
18 seconds or more
1. VVT angle when camshaft is retarded maximum
Less than 21 (Bank 1)
Less than 22 (Bank 2)
2. VVT angle when camshaft is retarded maximum
More than 46 (Bank 1)
More than 40 (Bank 2)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTCs P0335 and p0339 on page 05-532 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK VALVE TIMING (CHECK FOR LOOSE OR JUMPED TOOTH OF TIMING
(See page 14-206 )
OK: The matchmarks of the crankshaft pulley and camshaft pulley are aligned.
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING (See page 14-206 )
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
627
05-438
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXL-08
DTC
P0031
OXYGEN (A/F) SENSOR HEATER CONTROL
CIRCUIT LOW (BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
DTC
P0032
OXYGEN (A/F) SENSOR HEATER CONTROL
CIRCUIT HIGH (BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
DTC
P0051
OXYGEN (A/F) SENSOR HEATER CONTROL
CIRCUIT LOW (BANK 2 SENSOR 1)
DTC
P0052
OXYGEN (A/F) SENSOR HEATER CONTROL
CIRCUIT HIGH (BANK 2 SENSOR 1)
HINT:
Although the caption of detection item (DTC description) says ”oxygen sensor”, this DTC is related to the
”air fuel ratio sensor (A/F sensor)”.
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-629 .
HINT:
The ECM provides a pulse width modulated control circuit to adjust current through the heater. The A/F sensor heater circuit uses a relay on the +B side of the circuit.
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Drawing)
A/F Relay
From
Battery
A/F
ECM
A/F Sensor
+B Heater HT
AF-
Sensor
HA1H
AF+
A1A+
Duty
Control
A1AMREL
A87980
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0031
P0051
Heated current is 0.8 A or less when heater operates
(1 trip detection logic)
Open or short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
ECM
P0032
P0052
Hybrid IC high current limiter port is fail
(1 trip detection logic)
Open or short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
628
05-439
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
HINT:
Bank 1 is the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
Bank 2 is the bank that does not include cylinder No. 1.
Sensor 1 is the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
Sensor 2 is the sensor farthest away from the engine assembly.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor information to regulate the air-fuel ratio close to the stoichiometric ratio. This maximizes the catalytic converter’s ability to purify exhaust gas. The sensor detects oxygen
levels in the exhaust gas and sends this signal to the ECM.
The inner surface of the sensor element is exposed to outside air. The outer surface of the sensor element
is exposed to exhaust gas. The sensor element is made of platinum coated zirconia and includes an integrated heating element. The zirconia element generates small voltage when there is a large difference in
the oxygen concentrations of the exhaust and the outside air. The platinum coating amplifies the voltage
generation. When heated, the sensor becomes very efficient. If the temperature of the exhaust is low, the
sensor will not generate useful voltage signals without supplemental heating. The ECM regulates the supplemental heating using a duty-cycle approach to regulate the average current in the heater element. If the
heater current is out of the normal range, the sensor’s output signals will be inaccurate and the ECM cannot
regulate the air-fuel ratio properly.
When the heater current is out of the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction and
sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0031: A/F Sensor Heater (Bank 1) Range Check (Low current)
P0032: A/F Sensor Heater (Bank 1) Range Check (High current)
P0051: A/F Sensor Heater (Bank 2) Range Check (Low current)
P0052: A/F Sensor Heater (Bank 2) Range Check (High current)
Required sensors / components (Main)
A/F sensor heater
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P0031 and P0051
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
A/F sensor heater duty ratio
50 % or more
Time after engine start
10 seconds or more
P0032 and P0052
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Time after engine start
10 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0031 and P0051:
A/F sensor heater current
Less than 0.8 A
P0032 and P0052:
Hybrid IC high current limiter port
Fail
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
629
05-440
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
A/F sensor heater current
1.8 to 3.4 A at 20C (68F)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-385 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-387 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $07: A/F sensor heater
TLT
CID
Unit Conversion
Description of Test Data
Description of Test Limit
1
$01
Multiply by 0.00017
(A)
Maximum heater current (Bank 1)
Malfunction criterion for A/F sensor heater
1
$10
Multiply by 0.00017
(A)
Maximum heater current (Bank 2)
Malfunction criterion for A/F sensor heater
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-629 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
AF-
Disconnect the A6 or A7 A/F sensor connector.
Check the resistance between the terminals of the A/F
sensor.
Resistance:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
20C (68F)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
-
10 kΩ or higher
AF+
A52607
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
630
05-441
DIAGNOSTICS
2
(a)
(b)
2
5
5
2
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT RELAY (A/F)
1
3
-
Remove the A/F relay from the engine room R/B No. 2.
Check the resistance of the A/F relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
1
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
3
CHECK ECM (HA1H, HA2A VOLTAGE)
HA1H (+)
HA2A (+)
E1 (-)
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8-5 (HA1H) - E9-1 (E1)
E8-4 (HA2A) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
HINT:
E8
ECM
E9
ECM
A76903
The HA1H stands for the A/F sensor bank 1 sensor 1.
The HA2A stands for the A/F sensor bank 2 sensor 1.
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
631
05-442
DIAGNOSTICS
4
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (A/F SENSOR - ECM, A/F SENSOR - A/F RELAY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
E8
ECM
HA1H
Check the wire harness between the ECM and A/F sensors.
(1) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(2) Disconnect the A6 or A7 A/F sensor connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
HA2A
HT
A6 (Bank 1)
A7 (Bank 2)
A/F Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A6-1 (HT) - E8-5 (HA1H)
A7-1 (HT) - E8-4 (HA2A)
Below 1 Ω
A6-1 (HT) or E8-5 (HA1H) - Body ground
A7-1 (HT) or E8-4 (HA2A) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
+B
1
3
2
4
Y
A81695
A76787
A85836
(b)
Wire Harness Side
+B
HT
A6 (Bank 1)
A7 (Bank 2)
A/F Sensor
1
3
2
4
Check the wire harness between the A/F sensor and A/F
relay.
(1) Disconnect the A6 or A7 A/F sensor connector.
(2) Remove the A/F relay from the engine room R/B No.
2.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A6-2 (+B) - R/B No. 2 A/F relay terminal 3
A7-2 (+B) - R/B No. 2 A/F relay terminal 3
Below 1 Ω
A6-2 (+B) or R/B No. 2 A/F relay terminal 3 - Body ground
A7-2 (+B) or R/B No. 2 A/F relay terminal 3 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Engine Room R/B No. 2
A/F Relay
A76787
A76787
A87845
A87845
-
A92546
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
632
05-443
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXM-05
DTC
P0037
OXYGEN SENSOR HEATER CONTROL
CIRCUIT LOW (BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
DTC
P0038
OXYGEN SENSOR HEATER CONTROL
CIRCUIT HIGH (BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
DTC
P0057
OXYGEN SENSOR HEATER CONTROL
CIRCUIT LOW (BANK 2 SENSOR 2)
DTC
P0058
OXYGEN SENSOR HEATER CONTROL
CIRCUIT HIGH (BANK 2 SENSOR 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0136 on page 05-485 .
HINT:
The ECM provides a pulse width modulated control circuit to adjust current through the heater. The heated
oxygen sensor heater circuit uses a relay on the +B side of the circuit.
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 2 System Drawing)
Heated
Oxygen Sensor
EFI Relay
From
Battery
EFI NO. 1
Heater
EFI NO. 2
+B
ECM
HT1B
HT
Sensor
E1
OX1B
OX
E2
MREL
A90346
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0037
P0057
Heated current is 0.25 A or less when the heater operates with
+B greater than 11.5 V (1 trip detection logic)
Open or short in heater circuit of the heated oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater
EFI relay
ECM
P0038
P0058
Heated current exceeds 2 A when the heater operates
(1 trip detection logic)
Open or short in heater circuit of the heated oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater
EFI relay
ECM
HINT:
Bank 1 is the bank that includes cylinder No.1.
Bank 2 is the bank that does not include cylinder No.1.
Sensor 1 is the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
Sensor 2 is the sensor farthest away from the engine assembly.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
633
05-444
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The sensing portion of the heated oxygen sensor has a zirconia element that is used to detect oxygen concentration in the exhaust. If the zirconia element is at the proper temperature and the difference of the oxygen concentration between the inside and outside surface of the sensor is large, the zirconia element will
generate voltage signals. In order to increase the oxygen concentration detecting capacity in the zirconia
element, the ECM supplements the heat from the exhaust with heat from a heating element inside the sensor. When current in the sensor is out of the standard operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in
the heated oxygen sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
The ECM will set a high current DTC if the current in the sensor is more than 2 A when the heater is OFF.
Similarly, the ECM will set a low current DTC if the current is less than 0.25 A when the heater is ON.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0037: HO2S Heater (Bank 1) Range Check (Low current)
P0038: HO2S Heater (Bank 1) Range Check (High current)
P0057: HO2S Heater (Bank 2) Range Check (Low current)
P0058: HO2S Heater (Bank 2) Range Check (High current)
Required sensors / components (Main)
HO2S heater
Required sensors / components (Related)
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.3 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P0037 and P0057:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Either of the following conditions A and B is met:
-
Conditions A
-
Time after engine start
250 to 500 seconds
Vehicle speed
Within 55.9 mph (90 km/h)
Battery voltage
Less than 10.5 V
Pass or Fail detection in this driving cycle
None
Conditions B
-
Time after engine start
500 seconds or more
Vehicle speed
24.8 mph (40 km/h) or more
Battery voltage
Less than 10.5 V
Pass or Fail detection in this driving cycle
None
P0038 and P0058:
None
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0037 and P0057:
HO2S heater current when HO2S heater OFF
Less than 0.25 A (when battery voltage is 11.5 V or more)
P0038 and P0058:
HO2S heater current when HO2S heater ON
More than 2 A
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
HO2S heater current
0.4 to 1 A (at idle, warmed-up engine and +B: 11 to 14 V)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
634
05-445
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-385 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-387 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $04: HO2S heater
TLT
CID
Unit Conversion
1
$02
Multiply by 0.000076
(A)
1
$20
Multiply by 0.000076
(A)
Description of Test Data
Description of Test Limit
Maximum HO2S heater current
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Malfunction threshold for HO2S heater
Maximum HO2S heater current
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
Malfunction threshold for HO2S heater
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0136 on page 05-485 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs related to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
+B
HT +B
2 1
4 3
E1
(b)
HT
2 1
4 3
OX E1
OX
Bank 1
Bank 2
A87828
Disconnect the H10 or H6 heated oxygen sensor connector.
Check the resistance of the heated oxygen sensor terminals.
Standard (bank 1, 2 sensor 2):
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
H10-1 (HT) - H10-2 (+B)
H6-1 (HT) - H6-2 (+B)
20C (68F)
11 to 16 Ω
H10-1 (HT) - H10-4 (E1)
H6-1 (HT) - H6-4 (E1)
800C (1,472F)
23 to 32 Ω
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
635
05-446
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT RELAY (EFI)
1
3
(a)
(b)
2
5
5
2
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Check the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
1
3
NG
B60778
REPLACE RELAY
OK
3
CHECK ECM (HT1B OR HT2B VOLTAGE)
E2 (-)
(a)
(b)
HT1B (+) HT2B (+)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8-25 (HT1B) - E7-28 (E2)
E8-33 (HT2B) - E7-28 (E2)
9 to 14 V
HINT:
E7
ECM
E8
ECM
A76903
The HT1B stands for the heated oxygen sensor bank 1
sensor 2.
The HT2B stands for the heated oxygen sensor bank 2
sensor 2.
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
636
05-447
DIAGNOSTICS
4
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR - ECM, HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR - EFI RELAY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
E8
ECM
HT1B
Check the wire harness between the ECM and heated oxygen sensor.
(1) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(2) Disconnect the H10 or H6 heated oxygen sensor
connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
HT2B
Heated Oxygen Sensor
HT
+B
1
3
HT
+B
1
3
2
4
E1
OX
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
H10-1 (HT) or E8-25 (HT1B) - Body ground
H6-1 (HT) or E8-33 (HT2B) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E1
OX
H10 (Bank 1)
Tester Connection
H10-1 (HT) - E8-25 (HT1B)
H6-1 (HT) - E8-33 (HT2B)
2
4
H6 (Bank 2)
A81695
A81921
A92547
(b)
Wire Harness Side
Heated Oxygen Sensor
HT
+B
1
3
OX
-
HT
+B
1
3
2
4
E1
H10 (Bank 1)
OX
2
4
E1
H6 (Bank 2)
Check the wire harness between the heated oxygen sensor and EFI relay.
(1) Disconnect the H10 or H6 heated oxygen sensor
connector.
(2) Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H10-2 (+B) - J/B EFI relay terminal 3
H6-2 (+B) - J/B EFI relay terminal 3
Below 1 Ω
H10-2 (+B) or J/B EFI relay terminal 3 - Body ground
H6-2 (+B) or J/B EFI relay terminal 3 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Engine Room J/B
EFI Relay
A81921
A90291
A92548
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
637
05-448
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXN-05
DTC
P0100
MASS OR VOLUME AIR FLOW CIRCUIT
DTC
P0102
MASS OR VOLUME AIR FLOW CIRCUIT
LOW INPUT
DTC
P0103
MASS OR VOLUME AIR FLOW CIRCUIT
HIGH INPUT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter measures the amount of air flowing through the throttle valve. The ECM uses
this information to determine the fuel injection time and provide a proper air fuel ratio. Inside the MAF meter,
there is a heated platinum wire exposed to the flow of intake air.
By applying a specific current to the wire, the ECM heats this wire to a given temperature. The flow of incoming air cools the wire and an internal thermistor, changing their resistance. To maintain a constant current
value, the ECM varies the voltage applied to these components in the MAF meter. The voltage level is proportional to the air flow through the sensor. The ECM interprets this voltage as the intake air amount.
The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire and temperature sensor provide a bridge circuit, with
the power transistor controlled so that the potential of A and B remains equal to maintain the set temperature.
B+
Temperature sensor
Power Transistor
Platinum Hot Wire
(Heater)
A
B
Output
Voltage
Temperature
Sensor
Platinum Hot Wire (Heater)
A80089
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0100
When MAF meter circuit has an open or a short for more than
3 seconds
Open or short in MAF meter circuit
MAF meter
ECM
P0102
When MAF meter circuit has an open for more than 3 seconds
Open or short in MAF meter circuit
MAF meter
ECM
P0103
When MAF meter circuit has a short for more than 3 seconds
Open or short in MAF meter circuit
MAF meter
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
638
05-449
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0100, P0102 or P0103, use the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to confirm
the MAF ratio from the ALL menu (to reach the ALL menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST
/ ALL).
Air Flow Value (gm/s)
Approx. 0.0
271.0 or more
Malfunction
Open in MAF meter power source circuit
Open or short in VG circuit
Open in E2G circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is a defect in the sensor, or an open or short circuit, the voltage level will deviate from the normal
operating range. The ECM interprets this deviation as a defect in the MAF meter and sets a DTC.
Example:
The sensor voltage output is less than 0.2 V or more than 4.9 V and either condition continues for more than
3 seconds.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0100: MAF Meter Range Check (Chattering)
P0102: MAF Meter Range Check (Low voltage)
P0103: MAF Meter Range Check (High voltage)
Required sensors / components (Main)
MAF meter
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
3 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate: Engine RPM is less than 4,000 rpm
2 driving cycles: Engine RPM if 4,000 rpm or more
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0100:
MAF meter voltage
Less than 0.2 V, or more than 4.9 V
P0102:
MAF meter voltage
Less than 0.2 V
P0103:
MAF meter voltage
More than 4.9 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
MAF meter voltage
Between 0.4 and 2.2 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
639
05-450
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
M1
MAF Meter
Engine Room R/B No. 2
EFI NO. 2
2
B-W
2
1
1
EB1
2
+B
B-R
ECM
VG
1
R
3
30
VG
E7
29
E2G L-W
E2G
E7
2
Y
Engine Room J/B
3 2D
3
EFI Relay
5
5
2B
P-L
13
IK3
B
8
MREL
E5
1
2
EFI NO. 1
1
4 2F
2I
W
3
W-B
F7
FL Block
Assy
1
A
J2
J/C
W
FL
Main
Battery
EH
A88691
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
640
05-451
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (MAF RATE)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / MAF. Read the values.
Result:
Air Flow Rate (gm/s)
Proceed to
0.0
A
271.0 or more
B
MAF rate greater than 1 but less than 270.0
C
HINT:
The value must change when the throttle valve is opened or closed.
B
Go to step 6
C
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
A
2
CHECK MASS AIR FLOW METER (POWER SOURCE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Check the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard:
M1
MAF Meter
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-1 (+B) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
+B (+)
A54396
NG
Go to step 5
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
641
05-452
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK ECM (VG VOLTAGE)
VG (+)
(a) Start the engine.
(b) Check the voltage of the ECM connector.
HINT:
The shift position should be P or N and the A/C switch should
be turned OFF.
Standard:
E2G (-)
E7
ECM
A76903
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E7-30 (VG)
- E7-29 (E2G)
Engine is idling
0.5 to 3.0 V
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MAF METER - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
M1
MAF Meter
E2G
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-3 (VG) - E7-30 (VG)
M1-2 (E2G) - E7-29 (E2G)
Below 1 Ω
M1-3 (VG) or E7-30 (VG) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VG
E7
ECM
E2G
Y
A54396
A81699
VG
A85482
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
642
05-453
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MAF METER - EFI RELAY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
M1
MAF Meter
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-1 (+B) - J/B EFI relay terminal 3
Below 1 Ω
M1-1 (+B) or J/B EFI relay terminal 3 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
+B
Engine Room J/B
EFI Relay
A54396
A90291
A92539
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
INSPECT ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT (See page 05-674 )
6
INSPECT ECM (SENSOR GROUND)
(a)
E2G
E7
ECM
A76903
Check the resistance of the ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-29 (E2G) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
643
05-454
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MAF METER - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
M1
MAF Meter
E2G
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
VG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-3 (VG) - E7-30 (VG)
M1-2 (E2G) - E7-29 (E2G)
Below 1 Ω
M1-3 (VG) or E7-30 (VG) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E7
ECM
E2G
Y
A54396
A81699
VG
A85482
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
644
05-455
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0101
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
052N9-44
MASS OR VOLUME AIR FLOW CIRCUIT
RANGE/PERFORMANCE PROBLEM
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0100 on page 05-448 .
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0101
High voltage:
Conditions (a), (b) and (c) continue for more than 10 seconds
(2 trip detection logic):
(a) Engine speed less than 2,000 rpm
(b) Engine coolant temperature 70C (158F) or higher
(c) Voltage output of Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter more than 2.2
V (varies with Throttle Position [TP] sensor voltage)
Low voltage:
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for more than 10 seconds
(2 trip detection logic):
(a) Engine speed more than 300 rpm
(b) Voltage output of MAF meter less than 0.83 V
(varies with TP sensor voltage)
Trouble Area
MAF meter
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The MAF meter is a sensor that measures the amount of air flowing through the throttle valve. The ECM uses
this information to determine the fuel injection time and to provide an appropriate air-fuel ratio.
Inside the MAF meter, there is a heated platinum wire which is exposed to the flow of intake air. By applying
a specific electrical current to the wire, the ECM heats it to a specific temperature. The flow of incoming air
cools both the wire and an internal thermistor, changing their resistance. To maintain a constant current value, the ECM varies the voltage applied to these components of the MAF meter. The voltage level is proportional to the air flow through the sensor, and the ECM uses it to calculate the intake air volume.
If there is a defect in the sensor, or an open or short in the circuit, the voltage level deviates from the normal
operating range. The ECM interprets this deviation as a malfunction in the MAF meter and sets the DTC.
Example:
If the voltage is more than 2.2 V, or less than 0.83 V while idling, the ECM determines that there is a malfunction in the MAF meter and sets the DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0101: MAF Meter Rationality (Low voltage)
P0101: MAF Meter Rationality (High voltage)
Required sensors/ components (Main)
MAF meter
Required sensors/ components (Related)
Crankshaft position sensor, ECT sensor, Throttle position sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-377
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
645
05-456
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MAF Meter Rationality (High Voltage):
Engine RPM
Less than 2,000 rpm
ECT
70°C (158°F) or more
MAF Meter Rationality (Low Voltage):
Engine RPM
More than 300 rpm
Fuel cut
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
MAF Meter Rationality (High Voltage):
MAF meter voltage
More than 2.2 V (varies with throttle position sensor voltage)
MAF Meter Rationality (Low Voltage):
MAF meter voltage
Less than 0.54 V (varies with throttle position sensor voltage)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0100 on page 05-448 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT(IN ADDITION TO DTC P0101)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0101 and other DTCs are output
A
Only P0101 is output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0101 are output, perform the troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
A
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART (See page 05-412 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
646
05-457
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXO-05
DTC
P0110
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT
DTC
P0112
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT LOW
INPUT
DTC
P0113
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT HIGH
INPUT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Fig. 1
30
20
Resistance KΩ
10
Acceptable
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
- 20
(- 4)
0
32
20
68
40
104
60
140
80
176
100
212
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor, mounted on the Mass
Air Flow (MAF) meter, monitors the intake air temperature. The
IAT sensor has a thermistor that varies its resistance depending
on the temperature of the intake air. When the air temperature
is low, the resistance in the thermistor increases. When the temperature is high, the resistance drops. The variations in resistance are reflected as changes in voltage applied to the ECM
terminal (See Fig. 1).
The IAT sensor is connected to the ECM (see below). The 5 V
power source voltage in the ECM is applied to the IAT sensor
from terminal THA via resistor R.
That is, the resistor R and the IAT sensor are connected in series. When the resistance value of the IAT sensor changes in
accordance with changes in the IAT, the voltage at terminal THA
also changes. Based on this signal, the ECM increases the fuel
injection volume to improve the driveability during cold engine
operation.
Temp. C (F)
A67628
DTC No.
Proceed to
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0110
Step 1
Open or short in IAT (Intake
air temperature) sensor circuit for 0.5 seconds (1 trip
detection logic)
P0112
Step 4
Short in IAT sensor circuit for
0.5 seconds (1 trip detection
logic)
Open or short in IAT sensor circuit
IAT sensor (built in MAF meter)
ECM
P0113
Step 2
Open in IAT sensor circuit for
0.5 seconds (1 trip detection
logic)
Open or short in IAT sensor circuit
IAT sensor (built in MAF meter)
ECM
Open or short in IAT sensor circuit
IAT sensor (built in MAF meter)
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0110, P0112 or P0113, use the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to confirm
the IAT from the ALL menu (to reach the ALL menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL).
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-40 °C (-40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F) or more
Short circuit
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
647
05-458
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the intake air temperature. When the
sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the IAT
sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
The sensor voltage output equals to -40C (-40F), or more than 140C (284F), and either condition continue for 0.5 seconds or more.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0110: IAT Sensor Range Check (Chattering)
P0112: IAT Sensor Range Check (Low Resistance)
P0113: IAT Sensor Range Check (High Resistance)
Required sensors / components (Main)
IAT sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0110:
Less than 98.5 Ω, or more than 156 kΩ
IAT sensor resistance
P0112:
Less than 98.5 Ω [More than 140C (284F)]
IAT sensor resistance [IAT]
P0113:
IAT sensor resistance [IAT]
More than 156 kΩ [-40C (-40F)]
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
98.5 Ω to 156 kΩ [-39 to 140C (-40 to 284F)]
IAT sensor resistance [IAT]
WIRING DIAGRAM
M1
MAF Meter
(IAT Sensor)
ECM
5V
THA
20
THA
E7
L-B
4
E2
W-B
5
BR
5
S28
5
S29
BR
28
E2
E7
Short
Connector
A88688
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
648
05-459
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs related to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (INTAKE AIR
TEMPERATURE)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON. Push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR. Read the values.
Temperature: Same value as the actual intake air temperature.
Result:
Temperature Displayed
Proceed to
-40 °C (-40°F)
A
140°C (284°F) or more
B
OK (Same as present temperature)
C
HINT:
If there is an open circuit, the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool indicates -40°C (-40°F).
If there is a short circuit, the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool indicates 140°C (284°F) or more.
B
Go to step 4
C
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
649
05-460
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
OPEN IN WIRE HARNESS)
M1
MAF Meter
(a)
(b)
ECM
(c)
(d)
THA
E2
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Connect terminals THA and E2 of the M1 MAF meter wire
harness side connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
Wire Harness Side
M1
MAF Meter
THA
E2
OK
Y
A75743
A76903
A85506
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION AT SENSOR. IF
OK, REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
NG
3
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
OPEN IN ECM)
M1
MAF Meter
(a) Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
(b) Connect terminals THA and E2 of the E7 ECM connector.
HINT:
Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check for the
ECM connector.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(d) On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
ECM
THA
E2
THA
Y
A75742
A76903
E2
E7
ECM
OK
A85507
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
650
05-461
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION AT ECM. IF OK, REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
4
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
M1
MAF Meter
(a)
(b)
(c)
ECM
THA
E2
A75766
Disconnect the M1 MAF meter connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA
LIST/ALL/INTAKE AIR” and read its value displayed on
the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
OK:
Temperature value: -40°C (-40°F)
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
NG
5
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
SHORT IN ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
E7
ECM
M1
MAF Meter
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS/ENHANCED OBD II/DATA
LIST/ALL/INTAKE AIR” and read its value displayed on
the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
OK:
Temperature value: -40°C (-40°F)
ECM
THA
E2
Y
A81699
A75744
A85841
OK
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
651
05-462
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXP-05
DTC
P0115
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT
DTC
P0117
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT
LOW INPUT
DTC
P0118
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT
HIGH INPUT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor is built into the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor and changes the resistance value
according to the engine coolant temperature.
The structure of the sensor and connection to the ECM are the same as the Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
sensor.
HINT:
If the ECM detects the DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118, it operates the fail-safe function in which the ECT is
assumed to be 80C (176F).
DTC No.
Proceed to
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0115
Step 1
Open or short in ECT sensor
circuit for 0.5 seconds
Open or short in ECT sensor circuit
ECT sensor
ECM
P0117
Step 4
Short in ECT sensor circuit
for 0.5 seconds
Open or short in ECT sensor circuit
ECT sensor
ECM
P0118
Step 2
Open in ECT sensor circuit
for 0.5 seconds
Open or short in ECT sensor circuit
ECT sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118, use the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to confirm
the ECT from the ALL menu (to reach the ALL menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL).
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-40 °C (-40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F) or more
Short circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECT sensor is used to monitor the engine coolant temperature. The ECT sensor has a thermistor that
varies its resistance depending on the temperature of the engine coolant. When the coolant temperature
is low, the resistance in the thermistor increases. When the temperature is high, the resistance drops. The
variations in resistance are reflected in the voltage output from the sensor.
The ECM monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the engine coolant temperature.
When the sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault
in the ECT sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
When the ECM calculates that the ECT is -40C (-40F) or more than 140C (284F) and if either condition
continues for 0.5 seconds or more, the ECM will set a DTC.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
652
05-463
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0115: ECT Sensor Range Check (Chattering)
P0117: ECT Sensor Range Check (Low Resistance)
P0118: ECT Sensor Range Check (High Resistance)
Required sensors / components (Main)
ECT sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0115:
Less than 79 Ω, or more than 156 kΩ
ECT sensor resistance
P0117:
Less than 79 Ω [More than 140C (284F)]
ECT sensor resistance [ECT]
P0118:
ECT sensor resistance [ECT]
More than 156 kΩ [-40C (-40F)]
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
79 Ω to 156 kΩ [-39 to 140C (-40 to 284F)]
ECT sensor resistance [ECT]
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
E2
ECT Sensor
5V
THW
19
THW
E7
G-B
2
E2
W-B
1
BR
5
S28
5
S29
BR
28
E2
E7
Short
Connector
A88688
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
653
05-464
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs related to different system that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON. Push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP. Read the values.
Temperature: Same value as the actual engine coolant temperature.
Result:
Temperature Displayed
Proceed to
-40 °C (-40°F)
A
140°C (284°F) or more
B
OK (same as present temperature)
C
HINT:
If there is an open circuit, the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool indicates -40°C (-40°F).
If there is a short circuit, the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool indicates 140°C (284°F) or more.
B
Go to step 4
C
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
654
05-465
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
OPEN IN WIRE HARNESS)
E2
ECT Sensor
(a)
(b)
ECM
(c)
(d)
THW
E2
Disconnect the E2 ECT sensor connector.
Connect terminals 1 and 2 of the E2 ECT sensor wire harness side connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
Wire Harness Side
E2
ECT Sensor
OK
Y
75743
A66104
A85509
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION AT SENSOR. IF
OK,
REPLACE
ENGINE
COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
NG
3
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
OPEN IN ECM)
E2
ECT Sensor
(a) Disconnect the E2 ECT sensor connector.
(b) Connect terminals THW and E2 of the E7 ECM connector.
HINT:
Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check for the
ECM connector.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(d) On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
ECM
THW
E2
THW
Y
A75742
A76903
E2
E7
ECM
A85507
OK
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
655
05-466
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION AT ECM. IF OK, REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
4
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
E2
ECT Sensor
(a)
(b)
(c)
ECM
THW
E2
A75766
Disconnect the E2 ECT sensor connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: -40°C (-40°F)
OK
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
NG
5
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (CHECK FOR
SHORT IN ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
E7
ECM
E2
ECT Sensor
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the
following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
DATA LIST / ALL / COOLANT TEMP. Read the values.
OK:
Temperature value: -40°C (-40°F)
ECM
THW
E2
Y
A75744
A81699
A85842
OK
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
656
05-467
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0116
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05BNS-11
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT
RANGE/PERFORMANCE PROBLEM
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 on page 05-462 .
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0116
ECT is between 35C (95F) and 60C (140F) when engine
is started, and conditions (a) and (b) are met:
(a) Vehicle has accelerated and decelerated.
(b) ECT remains within 3°C (5.4°F) of the initial engine coolant
temperature (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
ECT
P0116
ECT is more than 60°C (140°F) when engine is started and
vehicle has accelerated and decelerated
ECT sensor records a temperature variation is within 1°C
(1.8°F) successively 6 times (6 trip detection logic)
ECT
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to monitor the engine coolant temperature. The ECT
sensor has a thermistor that varies its resistance depending on the temperature of the engine coolant. When
the coolant temperature is low, the resistance in the thermistor increases. When the temperature is high, the
resistance drops. The variations in resistance are reflected in the voltage output from the sensor. The ECM
monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the engine coolant temperature. When the sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the ECT
sensor and sets a DTC.
Examples:
1) Upon starting the engine, the ECT is between 35C (95F) and 60C (140F). If, after driving for 250 seconds, the ECT still remains within 3C (5.4F) of the starting temperature, a DTC will be set (2 trip detection
logic).
2) Upon starting the engine, the ECT is over 60C (140F). If, after driving for 250 seconds, the ECT still
remains within 1C (1.8F) of the starting temperature, a DTC will be set (6 trip detection logic).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0116: ECT Sensor Stuck at Low ECT
P0116: ECT Sensor Stuck at High ECT
Required sensors / components (Main)
ECT sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP sensor, IAT sensor, MAF meter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
250 seconds or more
MIL operation
2 driving cycles: ECT Sensor Stuck at Low ECT
6 driving cycles: ECT Sensor Stuck at High ECT
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-377
ECT Sensor Stuck at Low ECT:
Cumulative idle off period
250 seconds or more
Speed increase by 30 km/h (18.6 mph) or more
10 times or more
ECT
35 to 60C (95 to 140F)
IAT
-6.7 C (20F) or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
657
05-468
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
ECT Sensor Stuck at High ECT:
ECT
60C (140F) or more
-6.7 C (20F) or more
IAT
”Stop and
go”*1
”Steady driving and stop ”*2
Once or more
Once or more
HINT:
*1: Vehicle is stopped for 20 seconds or more and accelerated to more than 70 km/h (43.5 mph) within 40
seconds.
*2: Vehicle is driven by 65 km/h (40.4 mph) or more for 30 seconds or more and the vehicle speed reaches
43.5 mph (70 km/h). The vehicle is decelerated from 65 km/h (40.4 mph) to 3 km/h (1.86 mph) or less within
35 seconds and stopped for 10 seconds.
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
ECT Sensor Stuck at Low ECT:
ECT change
Less than 3C (5.4F)
ECT Sensor Stuck at High ECT:
ECT change
1C (1.8F) or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
ECT
Varies with actual ECT (Engine coolant temperature)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 and P0125 are output simultaneously, the ECT sensor circuit may
be open or shorted. Perform the troubleshooting of DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118 first.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
658
05-469
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXQ-05
DTC
P0120
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”A” CIRCUIT
DTC
P0122
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”A” CIRCUIT LOW INPUT
DTC
P0123
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”A” CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
DTC
P0220
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”B” CIRCUIT
DTC
P0222
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”B” CIRCUIT LOW INPUT
DTC
P0223
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”B” CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
DTC
P2135
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”A”/”B” VOLTAGE
CORRELATION
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
659
05-470
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
HINT:
Throttle Position Sensor
Magnet
ECM
IC No. 1
VC
VTA1
Throttle Position Sensor Output Voltage (V)
This Electronic Throttle Control System (ECTS) does not use a throttle cable.
This throttle position sensor is a non-contact type.
The throttle position sensor is mounted on the throttle body and it detects the opening angle of the throttle
valve. This sensor is electronically controlled and uses Hall-effect elements, so that accurate control and
reliability can be obtained. The throttle position sensor has 2 sensor elements/signal outputs: VTA1 and
VTA2. VTA1 is used to detect the throttle opening angle and VTA2 is used to detect malfunctions in VTA1.
Voltage applied to VTA1 and VTA2 changes between 0V and 5V in proportion to the opening angle of the
throttle valve. There are several checks that the ECM performs to confirm proper operation of the throttle
position sensor and VTA1.
The ECM judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these signals input from terminals VTA1
and VTA2, and the ECM controls the throttle motor to make the throttle valve angle properly in response to
driver inputs.
Fail Safe Angle
*1
5
VTA2
VTA1
2.55
2.25
0.93
0.69
6
0
Usable Range
84
Throttle Valve Opening Angle (deg.)
VTA2
E2
IC No. 2
Magnet
Throttle Valve Fully Closed
(Throttle Position expressed as percentage
(VTA1) 10 to 24 %)
Throttle Valve Fully Opened
(Throttle Position expressed as percentage
(VTA1) 64 to 96 %)
*1: Fail Safe Angle 6°
(Throttle Position expressed as percentage
(VTA1) about 16 %)
A19755
A19802
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
660
05-471
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
DTC Detection Condition
DTC No.
Condition (a) of DTC P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222 or
P0223 continues for 2 seconds
(open or short in the throttle position sensor circuit)
P0120
Detection conditions for DTCs P0122 and P0123 are not satisfied but condition (a) is satisfied
(a) VTA1 is 0.2 V or less or VTA1 is 4.8 V or more
Throttle position sensor
ECM
(a) VTA1 is 0.2 V or less
Throttle position sensor
Short in VTA1 circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
P0123
(a) VTA1 is 4.8 V or more
Throttle position sensor
Open in VTA1 circuit
Open in E2 circuit
Short in VC and VTA1 circuits
ECM
P0220
Detection conditions for DTCs P0222 and P0223 are not satisfied but condition (a) is satisfied
(a) VTA2 is 0.5 V or less or VTA2 is 4.8 V or more and
VTA1 is 0.2 V or more and VTA1 is 1.8 V or less
Throttle position sensor
ECM
(a) VTA2 is 0.5 V or less
Throttle position sensor
Short in VTA2 circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
P0223
(a) VTA2 is 4.8 V or more and
VTA1 is 0.2 V or more and VTA1 is 1.8 V or less
Throttle position sensor
Open in VTA2 circuit
Open in E2 circuit
Short in VC and VTA2 circuits
ECM
P2135
Condition (a) continues for 0.5 seconds or more, or
condition (b) continues for 0.4 seconds or more:
(a) Difference between VTA1 and VTA2 is 0.02 V or less
(b) VTA1 is 0.2 V or less and VTA2 is 0.5 V or less
Short in VTA1 and VTA2 circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
P0122
P0222
Trouble Area
HINT:
After confirming DTCs, use the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to confirm the throttle valve
opening percentage and closed throttle position switch condition.
”THROTTLE POS” is the VTA1 signal. ”THROTTLE POS #2” is the VTA2 signal.
Reference (Normal condition):
Tester display
Accelerator pedal released
Accelerator pedal fully depressed
THROTTLE POS
10 to 24 %
64 to 96 %
THROTTLE POS #2
2.1 to 3.1 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
661
05-472
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the throttle position sensor to monitor the throttle valve opening angle.
(a) There is a specific voltage difference between VTA1 and VTA2 for each throttle opening angle.
If the difference between VTA1 and VTA2 deviates from the specified range, the ECM interprets this
as a default and will set a DTC.
(b) VTA1 and VTA2 have each specific voltage operating range.
If VTA1 or VTA2 is out of the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault and will set
a DTC.
(c) VTA1 and VTA2 should never be close to the same voltage levels.
If the difference between VTA1 and VTA2 is within 0.02 V, the ECM interprets this as a short circuit
in the throttle position sensor system and will set a DTC.
FAIL SAFE
If the ETCS has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle control motor. The throttle control valve
returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16) by the force of the return spring. The ECM
then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in
accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0120: TP Sensor 1 Range Check (Chattering)
P0122: TP Sensor 1 Range Check (Low voltage)
P0123: TP Sensor 1 Range Check (High voltage)
P0220: TP Sensor 2 Range Check (Chattering)
P0222: TP Sensor 2 Range Check (Low voltage)
P0223: TP Sensor 2 Range Check (High voltage)
P2135: TP Sensor Range Check (Correlation)
Required sensors / components (Main)
TP (Throttle position) sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
Accelerator pedal ON: 2 seconds
Accelerator pedal OFF: 10 seconds
0.5 seconds or 0.4 seconds (P2135)
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0120:
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less, or 4.8 V or more
P0122:
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less
P0123:
VTA1 voltage
4.8 V or more
P0220:
VTA2 voltage
0.5 V or less, or 4.8 V or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
662
05-473
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
P0222:
VTA2 voltage
0.5 V or less
P0223:
VTA2 voltage when the VTA is 0.2 to 1.8 V
4.8 V or more
P2135:
Either of the following condition(s) is met:
Condition 1 or 2
Condition 1
-
Difference between VTA1 and VTA2 voltages
0.02 V or less
Condition 2
-
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less
VTA2 voltage
0.5 V or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VTA1 voltage
0.6 to 3.96 V
VTA2 voltage
2.25 to 4.8 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
T13
Throttle Position Sensor
VC
VTA1
VTA2
E2
ECM
18
VC
E7
Y
5
R-W
21
VTA1
E7
B-R
31
VTA2
E7
6
4
W-B
3
BR
5
S28
5
BR
S29
5V
28
E7 E2
Short
Connector
A88690
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs related to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
663
05-474
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Hand-held tester:
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (THROTTLE POS AND THROTTLE POS
#2)
(a)
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST
/ ALL / THROTTLE POS and THROTTLE POS #2. Read the values.
Result:
Throttle position expressed as percentage and voltage
Throttle position expressed as percentage and voltage
Throttle position expressed as percentage and voltage
Throttle position expressed as percentage and voltage
Accelerator pedal released
Accelerator pedal released
Accelerator pedal repressed
Accelerator pedal repressed
THROTTLE POS
(VTA1)
THROTTLE POS #2
(VTA2)
THROTTLE POS
(VTA1)
THROTTLE POS #2
(VTA2)
Trouble Area
Proceed to
0%
0 to 0.2 V
0%
0 to 0.2 V
VC circuit open
A
100 %
4.5 to 5.5 V
100 %
4.5 to 5.5 V
E2 circuit open
A
0 % or 100 %
2.1 to 3.1 V
(fail safe)
0 % or 100 %
2.1 to 3.1 V
(fail safe)
VTA1 circuit open or
ground short
A
about 16 %
(fail safe)
0 to 0.2 or 4.5 to 5.5 V
about 16 %
(fail safe)
0 to 0.2 or 4.5 to 5.5 V
VTA2 circuit open or
ground short
A
10 to 24 %
2.1 to 3.1 V
64 to 96 %
(does not fail safe)
4.5 to 5.5 V
(does not fail safe)
Throttle position sensor circuit is normal
B
B
Go to step 5
A
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
T13
Throttle Position Sensor
Disconnect the T13 throttle position sensor connector.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
E2
VTA2
VC
T13-5 (VC) T13-6 (VTA1) T13-4 (VTA2) T13-3 (E2) -
VTA1
E7-18
E7-21
E7-31
E7-28
Specified Condition
(VC)
(VTA1)
(VTA2)
(E2)
Below 1 Ω
T13-5 (VC) or E7-18 (VC) - Body ground
T13-6 (VTA1) or E7-21 (VTA1) - Body ground
T13-4 (VTA2) or E7-31 (VTA2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E7
ECM
VC
E2
Y
B53781
A81699
VTA1
VTA2
A85510
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
664
05-475
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM (VC VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
VC (+)
E7
E2 (-)
ECM
A76903
Disconnect the T13 throttle position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-18 (VC) - E7-28 (E2)
4.5 to 5.5 V
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
4
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSY (See page 10-18 )
GO
5
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
READ OUTPUT DTC (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR DTCS ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
Clear the DTC (see page 05-400 ).
Start the engine.
Run the engine at idle for 15 seconds or more.
Read the DTC (see page 05-400 ).
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223 and/or P2135 are output again
A
No DTC output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
A
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
665
05-476
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
T13
Throttle Position Sensor
Disconnect the T13 throttle position sensor connector.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
E2
VTA2
VC
T13-5 (VC) T13-6 (VTA1) T13-4 (VTA2) T13-3 (E2) -
VTA1
E7-18
E7-21
E7-31
E7-28
Specified Condition
(VC)
(VTA1)
(VTA2)
(E2)
Below 1 Ω
T13-5 (VC) or E7-18 (VC) - Body ground
T13-6 (VTA1) or E7-21 (VTA1) - Body ground
T13-4 (VTA2) or E7-31 (VTA2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E7
ECM
VC
E2
Y
B53781
A81699
VTA1
VTA2
NG
A85510
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2
INSPECT ECM (VC VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
VC (+)
E2 (-)
E7
ECM
A76903
Disconnect the T13 throttle position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage of the ECM connector.
Standard:
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-18 (VC) - E7-28 (E2)
4.5 to 5.5 V
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
3
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSY (See page 10-18 )
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
666
05-477
DIAGNOSTICS
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
READ OUTPUT DTC (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR DTCS ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
Clear the DTC (see page 05-400 ).
Start the engine.
Run the engine at idle for 15 seconds or more.
Read the DTC (see page 05-400 ).
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223 and/or P2135 are output again
A
No DTC output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
A
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
667
05-478
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0121
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
052NE-54
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”A” CIRCUIT
RANGE/PERFORMANCE PROBLEM
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0120 on page 05-469 .
DTC No.
P0121
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Condition (a) continues for 2.0 sec.:
(a) Difference between VTA1 and VTA2 deviates from threshold
Throttle position sensor
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the throttle position sensor to monitor the throttle valve opening angle.
This sensor includes 2 signals: VTA1 and VTA2. VTA1 is used to detect the throttle opening angle and VTA2
is used to detect malfunctions in VTA1. There are several checks that the ECM performs to confirm proper
operation of the throttle position sensor and VTA1.
The VTA1 and VTA2 voltage output difference should be less than 0.1V and more than 0.4V. If the voltage
output difference deviates from this range, the ECM concludes the throttle position sensor has a malfunction.The ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC will be set.
FAIL SAFE
If the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle
control motor. The throttle control valve returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16) by
the force of the return spring. The ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the
vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0121: TP (Throttle position) Sensor Rationality
Required sensors / components (Main)
TP sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following condition is met:
-
TP sensor 1 - (TP sensor 2 x 0.8)
Below 0.8 V or 1.6 V or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
668
05-479
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSY (See page 10-18 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
669
05-480
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0125
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
052NC-43
INSUFFICIENT COOLANT TEMPERATURE
FOR CLOSED LOOP FUEL CONTROL
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 on page 05-462 .
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0125
When ECT or IAT is less than -19.45°C (-3°F) at engine start
and 20 minutes or more after starting engine, ECT sensor
value is 20°C (68°F) or less (2 trip detection logic)
Cooling system
ECT sensor
Thermostat
Trouble Area
P0125
When ECT and IAT are between -19.45°C (-3°F) and
-8.34 °C (17°F) at engine start, 5 minutes or more after starting
engine and ECT sensor value is 20°C (68°F) or less (2 trip
detection logic)
Cooling system
ECT sensor
Thermostat
P0125
When ECT and IAT greater than -8.34°C (17°F) at engine
start
and 2 minutes or more after starting engine, ECT sensor value
is 20°C (68°F) or less (2 trip detection logic)
Cooling system
ECT sensor
Thermostat
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to monitor the temperature of the engine coolant.
The resistance of the sensor varies with the actual coolant temperature. The ECM applies a voltage to the
sensor and the varying resistance of the sensor causes the signal voltage to vary. The ECM monitors the
ECT signal voltage after engine start-up. If, after sufficient time has passed, the sensor still reports that the
engine is not warm enough for closed-loop fuel control, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the sensor or
cooling system and sets a DTC.
Example:
The ECT is 0C (32F) at engine start. After 5 minutes running time, the ECT sensor still indicates that the
engine is not warm enough to begin air fuel ratio feedback control of the air-fuel ratio. The ECM interprets
this as a fault in the sensor or cooling system and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0125: Insufficient ECT for Closed Loop
Required sensors / components (Main)
Thermostat, Cooling system
Required sensors / components (Related)
ECT sensor, MAF meter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 minutes: Engine start ECT is -8.34C (17F) or more
5 minutes: Engine start ECT is -19.45 to -8.34C (-3 to 17F)
20 minutes: Engine start ECT is less than -19.45C (-3F)
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-377
Fuel cut
OFF
Engine
Running
Idle
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Time until ”actual ECT” reaches ”Closed Loop ECT”
2 minutes: Engine start ECT is -8.34C (17F) or more
5 minutes: Engine start ECT is -19.45 to -8.34C (-3 to 17F)
20 minutes: Engine start ECT is less than -19.45C (-3F)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
670
05-481
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 and P0125 are output simultaneously, ECT sensor circuit may
be open or short. Perform the troubleshooting of DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118 first.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0125)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
Only P0125 are output
A
P0125 and other DTCs are output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0125 is output, perform the troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART (See page
05-412 )
A
2
(a)
INSPECT THERMOSTAT (See page 16-21 )
Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat.
OK: Valve opening temperature: 80 to 84C (176 to 183F).
HINT:
Also check the valve is completely closed under opening temperature as above.
NG
REPLACE THERMOSTAT (See page 16-31 )
OK
3
(a)
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM
Check the cooling system for excessive cooling, such as abnormal radiator fan operation, modified
cooling system and other defects.
OK: There is no modification of cooling system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COOLING SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
671
05-482
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0128
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05C1M-10
COOLANT THERMOSTAT (COOLANT
TEMPERATURE BELOW THERMOSTAT
REGULATING TEMPERATURE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) does not reach 75°C (167°F) despite sufficient engine warm-up time.
DTC No.
P0128
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Thermostat
Cooling system
ECT sensor
ECM
Conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met:
(a) Cold start
(b) Sufficient warm-up time has elapsed
(c) ECT is less than 75°C (167°F)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 seconds
Estimated ECT
Threshold
(75C (167F))
Indicated coolant temp. reading
ECT
Time
DTC set (after 2 driving cycle)
A82385
The ECM estimates the coolant temperature based on starting temperature, engine loads, and engine
speeds. The ECM then compares the estimated temperature with the actual ECT. When the estimated coolant temperature reaches 75C (167F), the ECM checks the actual ECT. If the actual ECT is less than 75C
(167F), the ECM will interpret this as a fault in the thermostat or engine cooling system and set a DTC.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
672
05-483
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0128: Coolant Thermostat
Required sensors / components (Main)
Thermostat
Required sensors / components (Related)
ECT sensor, IAT sensor, VSS
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
900 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-377
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. All of the following conditions are met:
Condition (a), (b) and (c)
(a) ECT at engine start - IAT at engine start
-15 to 7C (-27 to 12.6F)
(b) ECT at engine start
-10 to 56C (14 to 132.8F)
(c) IAT at engine start
-10 to 56C (14 to 132.8F)
2. All of the following conditions are met:
Condition (a), (b) and (c)
(a) ECT at engine start - IAT at engine start
More than 7C (12.6F)
(b) ECT at engine start
56C (132.8F) or less
(c) IAT at engine start
-10 C (14 F) or more
Accumulated time that vehicle speed is 80 mph (128 km/h)
or more
Less than 20 seconds
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Duration that both of the following conditions are met:
5 seconds or more
Estimated ECT
75C (167F) or more
Actual ECT
Less than 75C (167F)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-385 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-387 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $08: Thermostat
TLT
1
CID
$01
Unit Conversion
Multiply by 0.625 and subtract
40
(C)
Description of Test Data
ECT sensor output when estimated ECT
has reached to malfunction criterion
Description of Test Limit
Malfunction criteria for thermostat
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
673
05-484
DIAGNOSTICS
1
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM
Check the cooling system for excessive cooling, such as abnormal radiator fan operation, modified
cooling system and other defects.
OK: There is no modification of cooling system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COOLING SYSTEM
OK
2
(a)
INSPECT THERMOSTAT (See page 16-21 )
Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat.
OK: Valve opening temperature: 80 to 84C (176 to 183F).
HINT:
Also check the valve is completely closed under opening temperature as above.
NG
REPLACE THERMOSTAT
(See page 16-31 )
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
674
05-485
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05MON-01
DTC
P0136
OXYGEN SENSOR CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
(BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
DTC
P0137
OXYGEN SENSOR CIRCUIT LOW VOLTAGE
(BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
DTC
P0138
OXYGEN SENSOR CIRCUIT HIGH VOLTAGE
(BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
DTC
P0156
OXYGEN SENSOR CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION
(BANK 2 SENSOR 2)
DTC
P0157
OXYGEN SENSOR CICRCUIT LOW
VOLTAGE (BANK 2 SENSOR 2)
DTC
P0158
OXYGEN SENSOR CIRCUIT HIGH VOLTAGE
(BANK 2 SENSOR 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) is used to monitor oxygen in the exhaust gas. For optimum catalyst operation, the air fuel mixture (air-fuel ratio) must be maintained near the ideal stoichiometric ratio. The HO2S
output voltage changes suddenly in the vicinity of the stoichiometric ratio. The ECM adjusts the fuel injection
time so that the air-fuel ratio is nearly stoichiometirc.
The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.1 and 0.9 V in response to oxygen in the exhaust gas. If the oxygen in the exhaust gas increases, the air-fuel ratio becomes Lean. The ECM interprets Lean when the HO2S
voltage is below 0.45 V. If the oxygen in the exhaust gas decreases, the air-fuel ratio becomes Rich. The
ECM interprets Rich when the HO2S voltage is above 0.45 V.
Atmosphere
Ideal Air-fuel Mixture
Platinum Electrode
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Platinum Electrode
Heater
Coating (Ceramic)
Output Voltage
Housing
Richer - Air Fuel Ratio - Leaner
Cover
Exhaust Gas
A00798
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
675
05-486
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0136
Either of the following condition is met:
(a) Heated oxygen sensor voltage was less than 0.05 V for a
certain period (2-trip detection logic)
(b) Heated oxygen sensor did not switch for a certain period
(2-trip detection logic)
Heated oxygen sensor circuit (bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1)
Oxygen sensor heater (bank 1)
A/F sensor (bank 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 1)
P0137
Heated oxygen sensor voltage was less than 0.03 V for 90
seconds
Heated oxygen sensor circuit (bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1)
Oxygen sensor heater (bank 1)
P0138
Either of the following condition is met:
(a) Heated oxygen sensor voltage did not drop during fuel-cut
(2-trip detection logic)
(b) Heated oxygen sensor voltage was 1.2 V or higher for 10
seconds
Heated oxygen sensor circuit (bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1)
Oxygen sensor heater (bank 1)
P0156
Either of the following condition is met:
(a) Heated oxygen sensor voltage was less than 0.05 V for a
certain period (2-trip detection logic)
(b) Heated oxygen sensor did not switch for a certain period
(2-trip detection logic)
Heated oxygen sensor circuit (bank 2)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 2)
Oxygen sensor heater (bank 2)
A/F sensor (bank 2)
A/F sensor heater (bank 2)
P0157
Heated oxygen sensor voltage was less than 0.03 V for 90
seconds
Heated oxygen sensor circuit (bank 2)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 2)
Oxygen sensor heater (bank 2)
P0158
Either of the following condition is met:
(a) Heated oxygen sensor voltage did not drop during fuel-cut
(2-trip detection logic)
(b) Heated oxygen sensor voltage was 1.2 V or higher for 10
seconds
Heated oxygen sensor circuit (bank 2)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 2)
Oxygen sensor heater (bank 2)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the rear heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) in the following 3 items:
1. The HO2S voltage changes between Rich (more than 0.45 V) and Lean (less than 0.45 V) while
the vehicle is running (repeating acceleration and deceleration) for 8 minutes. If not, the ECM interprets
this as a malfunction, illuminates the MIL, and then sets a DTC.
2. The HO2S voltage does not remain at less than 0.05 V for a long time while the vehicle is running
(60% of the time in the 220 seconds monitor, the sensor output is less than 0.05 V). If it does, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction, illuminates the MIL, and then sets a DTC.
3. The sensor’s voltage drops to below 0.2 V (extremely Lean status) immediately when the vehicle
decelerates and the fuel cut is working for 6 seconds. If not, the ECM interprets this to mean the sensor’s response feature has deteriorated, illuminates the MIL, and then sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0136, P0156: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Output voltage)
P0136, P0156: Heated oxygen sensor impedance (Low impedance)
P0137, P0157: Heated oxygen sensor low voltage
P0138, P0158: Heated oxygen sensor high voltage
P0138, P0158: Heated oxygen sensor output voltage (Extremely high)
Required sensors/components (Main)
HO2S
Required sensors/components (Related)
ECT sensor, MAF meter, VSS
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 480 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate: Heated oxygen sensor low/high voltage
2 driving cycles: Others
Sequence operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
676
05-487
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
P0136, P0156 (Rear HO2S output voltage - case 1):
All of the following conditions are met:
Conditions 1, 2, 3 and 4
1. Malfunction determination in this driving cycle
Not detected
2. Engine
Running
3. Time after engine start
0 second or more
4. Either of the following conditions is met:
Conditions (a) or (b)
(a) Cumulative time while HO2S heater is operating
22 seconds or more
(b) HO2S voltage
Has reached to 0.2 V or more
P0136, P0156 (Rear HO2S output voltage - case 2):
Engine
Running
P0137, P0157 (Rear HO2S low voltage):
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Estimated heated oxygen sensor temperature
450C (842F) or more
Time after fuel-cut ended
30 seconds or more
P0138, P0158 (Rear HO2S high voltage):
Engine
Running
Battery voltage
11 V or more
P0138, P0158 (Rear HO2S output voltage during fuel-cut):
Engine coolant temperature
70C (158F) or more
Catalyst temperature
500C (932F) or more
Fuel-cut
Excuting
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0136, P0156 (Rear HO2S output voltage - case 1):
Both of the following conditions are met:
Conditions 1 and 2
1. Frequency that HO2S voltage changes between (a) and
(b)
0 time
(a) Maximum voltage
0.6 V or more
(b) Minimum voltage
Less than 0.45 V
2. Cumulative monitor time *1 of rear HO2S
320 seconds or more
*1: Monitor time is counted when all of the following conditions are met:
Conditions (a) and (b)
(a) Fuel system status
Closed-loop
(b) Idle
OFF
P0136, P0156 (Rear HO2S output voltage - case 2):
All of the following conditions are met:
1. Cumulative monitor time
*2 of
HO2S
Conditions 1, 2, 3, 4 and 5
160 seconds or more
2. Duration while HO2S voltage is below 0.05 V
96 seconds or more
3. Duration while HO2S voltage is higher than 0.7 V
Less than 32 seconds
4. Duration while HO2S voltage is 0.45 V to 0.7 V
Less than 48 seconds
5. Duration while HO2S voltage is 0.45 V or more
Less than 20 seconds
*2: Monitor time is counted when all of the following conditions are met:
Conditions 1, 2, 3 and 4
1. Intake air amount per revolution
7 g/rev or more
2. Vehicle speed
3 km/h (1.875 mph) or more
3. Idle
OFF
4. Fuel-cut
OFF
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
677
05-488
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
P0137, P0157 (Rear HO2S low voltage):
Sensor voltage
Lower than 0.03 V
P0138, P0158 (Rear HO2S high voltage):
Sensor voltage
1.2 V or more
P0138, P0158 (Rear HO2S output voltage during fuel-cut):
Either of the following conditions is met:
Conditions 1 or 2
1. Duration until rear HO2S voltage drops to 0.2 V after fuelcut start
6 seconds or more
2. Both of the following conditions are met:
Conditions (a) and (b)
(a) Rear HO2S voltage when fuel-cut starts
0.5 V or more
(b) Duration that HO2S voltage is 0.2 to 0.35 V
1 second or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
HO2S voltage
Varies between 0.1 and 0.9 V
O2S TEST RESULT (MODE 05)
Refer to page 05-383 for detailed information.
TEST ID/COMP ID
Description of TEST VALUE
Conversion Factor
Unit
Standard Value
$07
Minimum HO2S voltage
N/A
V
Less than TEST LIMIT
$08
Maximum HO2S voltage
N/A
V
More than TEST LIMIT
$31
Average time per one-cycle of
HO2S frequency that HO2S
switches Rich to Lean
N/A
Second
Less than TEST LIMIT
$32
Average time per one-cycle of
HO2S frequency that HO2S
switches Lean to Rich
N/A
Second
Less than TEST LIMIT
$37
Time until HO2S voltage drops
to 0.2 V during fuel-cut
N/A
Second
Less than TEST LIMIT
$81
Percentage in monitoring time
while HO2S voltage is lower
than 0.05 V
Multiply by 0.39
%
Less than TEST LIMIT
$84
Percentage in monitoring time
while HO2S voltage is higher
than 0.7 V
Multiply by 0.39
%
Less than TEST LIMIT
$85
Continuous time while HO2S
voltage is higher than 0.45 V
Multiply by 0.262
Second
Less than TEST LIMIT
$87
Percentage in monitoring time
while HO2S voltage is higher
than 0.45 V
Multiply by 0.39
%
More than TEST LIMIT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
678
05-489
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B No. 2
ECM
EFI NO. 2
2
1
25
HT1B
E8
R-Y
2
2
B-W
1
EB1
Y
B-R
H10
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
5
IM1
B-R
GR
1 HT
IM1 6
BR
21
OX1B
E8
W
+B 2
IM1 3
*1
Engine Room J/B
3 2D
W
5
2B
3 EFI Relay 1
B
3 OX
2 IM1
E1
4
H6
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
B-R
BR
5
33
HT2B
E8
W-L
2 +B
HT 1
2
*1
B
EFI NO. 1
4 E1
OX 3
5
S28
5
S29
29
OX2B
E8
BR
1
4 2F
2I
Short Connector
W
3
W-B
F7
FL Block
Assy
1
28
E7 E2
BR
P-L
13
IK3
8
E5
B
MREL
A
R
J2
J/C
W
4 IM1
FL
Main
A
BR
A
J7
J/C
A
BR
Battery
EH
ED
*1:
Shielded
A88692
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
679
05-490
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(a), (b)
Vehicle speed
Once
40 sec.
or more
Twice
40 sec.
or more
(d)
(d)
60 km/h
(38 mph)
Idling (c)
(e)
12 times
40 sec.
or more
(d)
(e)
(f)
IG SW OFF
Warm up
10 sec.
(engine coolant
or more
temperature
is more than 75C)
10 sec.
or more
10 sec.
or more
A58686
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Switch the hand-held tester from the normal mode to the check (test) mode (see page 05-402 ).
(c) Start the engine and warm up the engine untill engine coolant temperature is more than 75C.
(d) Drive the vehicle at 60 km/h (38 mph) or more for 40 seconds or more.
(e) Let the engine idle for 10 seconds or more.
(f)
Perform steps (d) to (e) 12 times.
HINT:
If a malfunction exists, the MIL will illuminate during step (f).
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of a malfunction will not occur. If you
do not have a hand-held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after performing steps from (c) to (f), then
perform steps from (c) to (f) again.
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (P0137 and/or P0157)
Warm up the engine and run the engine at 60 km/h (38 mph) for 7 minutes.
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (P0138 and/or P0158)
Warm up the engine and run the engine at idle for 30 seconds.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
It is possible the malfunctioning area can be found using the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation. The
A/F CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential trouble
areas are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume by 12.5 % or increases the injection volume by
25 %.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(5) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine idle (press the right or left button).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
680
05-491
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → rich output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5 % → lean output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → rich output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5 % → lean output: Less than 0.4 V
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Output voltage of A/F sensor
(sensor 1)
Output voltage of heated oxygen
sensor (sensor 2)
Injection volume
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 1 Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
OK
More than 0.55 V
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 2 Output voltage
A/F sensor
(A/F sensor, heater, A/F sensor circuit)
Output voltage
NG
Injection volume
More than 0.55 V
OK
Less than 0.4V
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 3 Output voltage
NG
Heated oxygen sensor
(heated oxygen sensor,
heater, heated oxygen sensor
circuit)
NG
Extremely rich or lean actual
air-fuel ratio
(Injector, fuel pressure, gas
leakage in exhaust system,
etc.)
Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
OK
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 4 Output voltage
Almost
No reaction
OK
Less than 0.4V
+25 %
Less than 3.0V
Output voltage
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Mainly suspected
Trouble Area
Output voltage
NG
Almost
No reaction
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables the technician to check the graph of the voltage output from
both the A/F sensor and the heated oxygen sensor.
To display the graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2” by pressing ”YES”, and then ”ENTER”. Then press ”F4”.
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
681
05-492
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT
(a)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0138 and/or P0158 are output
A
P0137 and/or P0157 are output
B
P0136 and/or P0156 are output
C
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0136, P0137, P0138, P0156, P0157 and/or P0158 are output, perform the troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
Go to step 9
C
Go to step 6
A
2
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (OUTPUT
VOLTAGE OF HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Turn ON the ignition switch. Push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / O2S B1S2.
Run the engine at idle.
Read the output voltage of the heated oxygen sensor during idling.
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage
Proceed to
More than 1.2 V
A
Less than 1.0 V
B
B
Go to step 5
A
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(a)
(b)
(c)
E8
ECM
HT1B
HT2B
Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for 5 minutes.
Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
OX1B
OX2B
A81695
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8-25 (HT1B) - E8-21 (OX1B)
10 kΩ or higher
E8-33 (HT2B) - E8-29 (OX2B)
10 kΩ or higher
E8-25 (HT1B) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E8-33 (HT2B) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE ECM
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
682
05-493
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (CHECK FOR SHORT)
(a)
(b)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
HT +B
+B
1 2
3 4
E1
Disconnect the H10 heated oxygen sensor connector.
Measure the resistance of the sensor side connectors.
Standard:
HT
2 1
4 3
OX E1
H10 (Bank 1)
OX
H6 (Bank 2)
A87828
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H10-1 (+B) - H10-3 (E1)
10 kΩ or higher
H10-1 (+B) - H10-4 (OX)
10 kΩ or higher
H6-2 (+B) - H6-4 (E1)
10 kΩ or higher
H6-2 (+B) - H6-3 (OX)
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
5
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (CHECK MODE)
Change the ECM to check mode with the hand-held tester.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / CHECK MODE.
Warm up the engine and drive the vehicle at over 25 mph (40 km/h) for an accumulated total of 10
minutes.
(b)
HINT:
Driving should be continued for 10 minutes consecutively, but it is not necessary to maintain a speed of 25
mph (40 km/h) during this time.
(c) Read the DTC.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P0138 and/or P0158 are output
A
No DTC
B
B
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
A
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
6
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (OUTPUT
VOLTAGE OF HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR)
(a) After warming up the engine, run the engine at 2,500 rpm for 3 minutes.
(b) Read the output voltage of the heated oxygen sensor when the engine rpm is suddenly increased.
HINT:
Quickly accelerate the engine to 4,000 rpm 3 times by using the accelerator pedal.
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage: Alternates 0.4 V or less and 0.5 V or more.
OK
Go to step 10
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
683
05-494
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HEATER RESISITANCE)
(a)
(b)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
HT +B
+B
1 2
3 4
HT
2 1
4 3
OX E1
E1
OX
H6 (Bank 2)
H10 (Bank 1)
A87828
Disconnect the H10 heated oxygen sensor connector.
Measure the resistance of the heated oxygen sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
H10-2 (HT) - H10-1 (+B)
20C (68F)
11 to 16 Ω
H6-1 (HT) - H6-2 (+B)
20C (68F)
11 to 16 Ω
H10-2 (HT) - H10-1 (+B)
800C (1,472F)
23 to 32 Ω
H6-1 (HT) - H6-2 (+B)
800C (1,472F)
23 to 32 Ω
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OK
8
INSPECT RELAY (EFI)
1
3
2
5
1
2
5
(a)
(b)
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Measure the resistance of the EFI relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
684
05-495
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
(a)
Check the wire harness between the ECM and heated oxygen sensor.
(1) Disconnect the H10 heated oxygen sensor connector.
(2) Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard:
Heated Oxygen Sensor
+B
HT
1 2
3 4
2 1
4 3
OX
+B
HT
E1
H10 (Bank 1)
E1
OX
H6 (Bank 2)
E8
ECM
OX1B
HT1B
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H10-4 (OX) - E8-21 (OX1B)
Below 1 Ω
H10-2 (HT) - E8-25 (HT1B)
Below 1 Ω
H6-3 (OX) - E8-29 (OX2B)
Below 1 Ω
H6-1 (HT) - E8-33 (HT2B)
Below 1 Ω
H10-4 (OX) or E8-21 (OX1B) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
H10-2 (HT) or E8-25 (HT1B) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
H6-3 (OX) or E8-29 (OX2B) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
H6-1 (HT) or E8-33 (HT2B) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
OX2B
HT2B
A81921
A81695
A92549
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 2 System Drawing)
EFI Relay
From
Battery
EFI NO. 1
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heater
EFI NO. 2
+B
HT1B
HT
Sensor
E1
ECM
OX1B
OX
E2
MREL
A90346
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
685
05-496
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
10
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern.
GO
11
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (DTC P0136 AND/OR P0156 ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0136 and/or P0156 are not output again
A
P0136 and/or P0156 are output again
B
A
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
B
12
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
GO
13
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern.
GO
14
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (DTC P0136 AND/OR P0156 ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0136 and/or P0156 are not output again
A
P0136 and/or P0156 are output again
B
A
REPAIR COMPLETED
B
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
686
05-497
DIAGNOSTICS
15
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST USING HAND-HELD TESTER
Start the engine and warm it up.
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn ON the ignition switch and the hand-held tester main switch.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / INJ VOL.
Using the hand-held tester, change the injection volume to check the A/F sensor output and heated
oxygen sensor output values below.
HINT:
Change the injection volume from -12.5 % to +12.5 %.
Result:
A/F sensor output remains more than 3.3 V or A/F sensor output remains less than 3.3 V
(Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume)
Injection Volume
+12.5 %
-12.5 %
Malfunction
A/F Sensor Output
Normal
3.3 V
Heated Oxygen Sensor Output
Malfunction
1V
0
A87979
OK
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE EXTREMLY RICH OR LEAN ACTUAL AIR FUEL RATIO(INJECTOR, FUEL
PRESSURE, GAS LEAKAGE IN EXHAUST SYSTEM, ETC.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
687
05-498
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXR-06
DTC
P0171
SYSTEM TOO LEAN (BANK 1)
DTC
P0172
SYSTEM TOO RICH (BANK 1)
DTC
P0174
SYSTEM TOO LEAN (BANK 2)
DTC
P0175
SYSTEM TOO RICH (BANK 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The fuel trim is related to the feedback compensation value, not to the basic injection time. The fuel trim includes the short-term fuel trim and the long-term fuel trim.
The short-term fuel trim is the short-term fuel compensation used to maintain the air-fuel ratio at the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio. The signal from the A/F sensor indicates whether the air-fuel ratio is RICH or LEAN
compared to the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio. This variance triggers a reduction in the fuel volume if the airfuel ratio is RICH, and an increase in the fuel volume if it is LEAN.
The short-term fuel trim varies from the central value due to individual engine differences, wear over time
and changes in the operating environment. The long-term fuel trim, which controls overall fuel compensation, steadies long-term deviations of the short-term fuel trim from the central value.
If both the short-term fuel trim and the long-term fuel trim are LEAN or RICH beyond a certain value, it is
detected as a malfunction and the MIL is illuminated and a DTC is set.
DTC No.
P0171
P0174
P0172
P0175
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
When air-fuel ratio feedback is stable after warming up engine,
fuel trim is considerably in error on LEAN side
(2 trip detection logic)
Air induction system
Injector blockage
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F relay
PCV valve and hose
PCV hose connection
When air-fuel ratio feedback is stable after warming up engine,
fuel trim is considerably in error on RICH side
(2 trip detection logic)
Injector leak, blockage
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Ignition system
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
HINT:
When DTC P0171 or P0174 is recorded, the actual air-fuel ratio is on the LEAN side. When DTC
P0172 or P0175 is recorded, the actual air-fuel ratio is on the RICH side.
If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the air-fuel ratio is LEAN and DTC P0171 or P0174 may be recorded.
The MIL then illuminates.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
688
05-499
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
+35 (%): Threshold at LEAN
1.35
Fuel Compensation
Amount
1.0
-35 (%): Threshold at RICH
0.65
A82386
Under closed-loop fuel control, fuel injection amounts that deviate from the ECM’s estimated fuel amount
will cause a change in the long-term fuel trim compensation value. This long-term fuel trim is adjusted when
there are persistent deviations in the short-term fuel trim values. And the deviation from the simulated fuel
injection amount by the ECM affects a smoothed fuel trim learning value. The smoothed fuel trim learning
value is the combination of smoothed short-term fuel trim (fuel feedback compensation value) and
smoothed long-term fuel trim (learning value of the air-fuel ratio). When the smoothed fuel trim learning value exceeds the DTC threshold, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the fuel system and sets a DTC.
Example:
The smoothed fuel trim learning value is more than +35 % or less than -35 %. The ECM interprets this as
a failure in the fuel system.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0171: Fuel System Lean (Bank 1)
P0172: Fuel System Rich (Bank 1)
P0174: Fuel System Lean (Bank 2)
P0175: Fuel System Rich (Bank 2)
Required sensors / components (Main)
Fuel system
Required sensors / components (Related)
A/F sensor, MAF meter, CKP sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
689
05-500
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Fuel system
Closed Loop
Throttle position learning
Completed
Either of the following conditions is met:
-
Engine RPM
Less than 1,100 rpm
Intake air amount
0.22 g/rev or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Fuel Trim Lean:
Smoothed fuel trim learning value
35 %* or more
Fuel Trim Rich:
Smoothed fuel trim learning value
-35 %* or more
HINT:
*: The threshold value varies with the ECT.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-629 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
It is possible the malfunctioning area can be found using the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation. The
A/F CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential trouble
areas are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume by 12.5 % or increases the injection volume by
25 %.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(5) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine idling (press the right or left button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: Less than 0.4 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
690
05-501
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay.
Output voltage of A/F sensor
(sensor 1)
Output voltage of heated oxygen
sensor (sensor 2)
Injection volume
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 1 Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
OK
More than 0.55 V
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 2 Output voltage
A/F sensor
(A/F sensor, heater, A/F sensor circuit)
Output voltage
NG
Injection volume
More than 0.55 V
OK
Less than 0.4V
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 3 Output voltage
Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
OK
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
NG
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 4 Output voltage
Almost
No reaction
OK
Less than 0.4V
+25 %
Less than 3.0V
Output voltage
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Mainly suspected
Trouble Area
Output voltage
NG
Almost
No reaction
NG
Heated oxygen sensor
(heated oxygen sensor,
heater, heated oxygen sensor
circuit)
Extremely rich or lean actual
air-fuel ratio
(Injector, fuel pressure, gas
leakage in exhaust system,
etc.)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables the technician to check and graph the voltage outputs of
both the A/F sensor and the heated oxygen sensor.
For displaying the graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2” by pressing ”YES” and push ”ENTER”. Then press ”F4”.
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a RICH air-fuel mixture. Check the conditions that would
cause the engine to run with a RICH air-fuel mixture.
A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a LEAN air-fuel mixture. Check the conditions that would
cause the engine to run with a LEAN air-fuel mixture.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
691
05-502
DIAGNOSTICS
1
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Check for vacuum leaks in air induction system.
OK: No vacuum leak.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF PCV HOSE
OK: PCV hose is connected correctly, and PCV hose is not damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
3
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (INJECTION AND VOLUME) (See page 11-38 )
Standard:
Injection volume
Difference between each injector
60 to 73 cm3 (3.7 to 4.5 cu in.) per 15 seconds
13 cm3 (0.8 cu in.) or less
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
(See page 11-46 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
692
05-503
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT MASS AIR FLOW METER
(a)
(b)
Air
E2
THA
5
VG
+B
E2G
4 3 2 1
(c)
30
20
10
Remove the MAF meter.
Check the output voltage.
(1) Apply battery voltage across terminals +B and E2G.
(2) Connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal
VG, and negative (-) tester probe to terminal E2G.
(3) Blow air into the MAF meter, and check that the voltage fluctuates.
Check the resistance of the IAT sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
THA (4) - E2 (5)
-20 C (-4F)
13.6 to 18.4 kΩ
THA (4) - E2 (5)
20C (68F)
2.21 to 2.69 kΩ
THA (4) - E2 (5)
60C (140F)
0.49 to 0.67 kΩ
Resistance kΩ
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
Acceptable
0.1
-20
(-4)
0 20 40 60 80 100
(32) (80) (104) (140)(176) (212)
TemperatureC(F)
A60548
NG
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
693
05-504
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
Ohmmeter
Remove the ECT sensor.
Check the resistance of the ECT sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
20C (68F)
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ
1-2
80C (176F)
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ
30
20
10
5
Resistance KΩ
Acceptable
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
-20
S01196
S01699
(-4)
0
20 40 60 80 100
NOTICE:
When checking the ECT sensor in the water, be careful not
to allow water to go into the terminals. After the check, dry
the sensor.
HINT:
Alternate procedure: Connect an ohmmeter to the installed
ECT sensor and read the resistance. Use an infrared thermometer to measure the engine temperature in the immediate vicinity of the sensor. Compare these values to the resistance/temperature graph. Change the engine temperature (warm up or
allow to cool down) and repeat the test.
(32) (68) (104) (140) (176) (212)
Temperature C (F)
A81700
NG
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
OK
6
CHECK FOR SPARK AND IGNITION (See page 18-7 )
OK: Spark occurs.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
OK
7
(a)
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE (See page 11-38 )
Check the fuel pressure (high or low pressure).
Standard:
Fuel pressure: 304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 50 psi)
NG
REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
OK
8
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
OK: No gas leak.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE EXHAUST
LEAKAGE POINT (See page 15-5 )
GAS
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
694
05-505
DIAGNOSTICS
9
(a)
(b)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (BANK 1, 2 SENSOR 1))
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC 3.
Warm up the A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately
90 seconds.
Read A/F sensor voltage output on the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Hand-held tester only:
Enter the following menus: ENHANCED OBD II / SNAPSHOT / MANUAL SNAPSHOT / USER DATA.
Select ”AFS B1 S1 or AFS B2 S1/ENGINE SPD” and press YES.
Monitor the A/F sensor voltage carefully.
Check the A/F sensor voltage output under the following conditions:
(1) Allow engine to idle for 30 seconds.
(2) Running the engine at approximately 2,500 rpm (where engine RPM is not suddenly changed).
(3) Raise the engine speed to 4,000 rpm and quickly release the accelerator pedal so that the throttle
is fully closed.
Standard:
Condition (1) and (2)
Voltage change of 3.3 V (0.66 V)* (between approximately 3.1 to 3.5 V) as shown in the illustration.
Condition (3)
A/F sensor voltage increases to 3.8 V (0.76 V)* or more when fuel is cut during engine deceleration, as shown in the illustration.
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
HINT:
*: Voltage when using the OBD II scan tool.
Normal Condition
Malfunction Condition
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(1) Idle
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
A/F
Sensor
Voltage
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
Engine
RPM
Engine
RPM
”Condition (3)”
3.8 V or More
A/F
Sensor
Voltage
Fuel Cut
”Condition (1), (2)”
Change approximately 3.3 V
Fuel Cut
When A/F sensor circuit is malfunctioning,
voltage output does not change
A72304
HINT:
Whenever the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at approximately 3.3 V (0.660 V)* (see ”Malfunction Condition” graphic) under any condition as well as the above conditions, the A/F sensor may
have an open circuit (this will happen also when the A/F sensor heater has an open circuit).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
695
05-506
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Whenever the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at a certain value of approximately 3.8 V (0.76
V)* or more, or 2.8 V (0.56 V)* or less (see ”Malfunction Condition” graphic) under any condition as
well as the above conditions, the A/F sensor may have a short circuit.
The ECM will stop fuel injection (fuel cut) during engine deceleration. This will cause a LEAN condition
and should result in a momentary increase in A/F sensor voltage output.
The ECM must establish a closed throttle position learned value to perform fuel cut. If the battery terminal has been disconnected, the vehicle must be driven over 10 mph to allow the ECM to learn the
closed throttle position.
When the vehicle is driven:
The output voltage of the A/F sensor may be below 2.8 V (0.76 V)* during fuel enrichment. For the
vehicle, this translates to a sudden increase in speed with the accelerator pedal fully depressed when
trying to overtake another vehicle. The A/F sensor is functioning normally.
The A/F sensor is a current output element, and therefore the current is converted into voltage inside
the ECM. If measuring voltage at connectors of A/F sensor or ECM, you will observe a constant voltage.
*: Voltage when using the OBD II scan tool.
OK
Go to step 17
NG
10
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
AF-
Disconnect the A6 or A7 A/F sensor connector.
Check the resistance of the A/F sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
20C (68F)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
-
10 kΩ or higher
AF+
A52607
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
11
INSPECT RELAY (A/F)
1
3
(a)
(b)
2
5
5
2
Remove the A/F relay from the engine room R/B No. 2.
Check the resistance of the A/F relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
1
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
696
05-507
DIAGNOSTICS
12
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
HT
A6 (Bank 1)
A7 (Bank 2)
A/F Sensor
AF+
+B
Disconnect the A6 or A7 A/F sensor connector.
Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
1 2
3 4
A6-3 (AF+) A6-4 (AF-) A6-1 (HT) A7-3 (AF+) A7-4 (AF-) A7-1 (HT) -
AF-
E8-22 (A1A+)
E8-30 (A1A-)
E8-5 (HA1H)
E8-23 (A2A+)
E8-31 (A2A-)
E8-4 (HA2A)
Below 1 Ω
A6-3 (AF+) or E8-22 (A1A+) - Body ground
A6-4 (AF-) or E8-30 (A1A-) - Body ground
A6-1 (HT) or E8-5 (HA1H) - Body ground
A7-3 (AF+) or E8-23 (A2A+) - Body ground
A7-4 (AF-) or E8-31 (A2A-) - Body ground
A7-1 (HT) or E8-4 (HA2A) - Body ground
E8
ECM
HA2A
HA1H
A2A+
Specified Condition
10 kΩ or higher
A1A+
A1AA2A-
Y
A76787
A81695
A85512
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Drawing)
A/F Relay
From
Battery
A/F
ECM
A/F Sensor
+B
Heater
HT
HA1H
AF-
Sensor
AF+
A1A+
Duty
Control
A1AMREL
A87980
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
13
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
697
05-508
DIAGNOSTICS
14
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
(e)
60 to 120 km/h
(38 to 75 mph)
Idling
IG SW OFF
(d)
2 min.
3 to 5 min.
Time
(a), (b), (c)
A79199
(a)
Clear the DTCs.
(1) Disconnect the battery cable or remove the EFI NO. 1 and ETCS fuses for 60 seconds or more.
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Switch the hand-held tester from the normal mode to the check mode (see page 05-402 ).
Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessory switches OFF.
Drive the vehicle at 60 to 120 km/h (38 to 75 mph) and engine speed at 1,400 to 3,200 rpm for 3 to
5 minutes.
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
HINT:
If a malfunction exists, the MIL will be illuminated during step (e).
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of a malfunction will not occur. If you
do not have a hand-held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after performing steps (d) and (e), then
perform step (e) again.
GO
15
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 AND/OR P0175 ARE OUTPUT
AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 and/or P0175 are not output again
A
DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 and/or P0175 are output again
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 ) AND PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(Refer to step 14)
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
698
05-509
DIAGNOSTICS
16
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
YES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL (DTCS P0171, P0172, P0174 AND/OR P0175)
17
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern (refer to step 14).
GO
18
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 AND/OR P0175 ARE OUTPUT
AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 and/or P0175 are not output again
A
DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 and/or P0175 are output again
B
B
Go to step 22
A
19
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
20
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
GO
21
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 AND/OR P0175 ARE OUTPUT
AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
DTC ”P0171, P0172, P0174 and/or P0175” are output again
A
DTC ”P0171, P0172, P0174 and/or P0175” are not output again
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 ) AND PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTER
(Refer to step 14)
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
699
05-510
DIAGNOSTICS
22
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
YES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL (DTCS P0171, P0172, P0174 AND/OR P0175)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
700
05-51 1
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXS-05
DTC
P0300
RANDOM/MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE
DETECTED
DTC
P0301
CYLINDER 1 MISFIRE DETECTED
DTC
P0302
CYLINDER 2 MISFIRE DETECTED
DTC
P0303
CYLINDER 3 MISFIRE DETECTED
DTC
P0304
CYLINDER 4 MISFIRE DETECTED
DTC
P0305
CYLINDER 5 MISFIRE DETECTED
DTC
P0306
CYLINDER 6 MISFIRE DETECTED
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When a misfire occurs in the engine, hydrocarbons (HC) are output in high concentrations. If this HC concentration is high enough, there could be an increase in exhaust emission levels. High concentrations of HC
can also cause the temperature of the catalyst to increase, possibly damaging the catalyst. To prevent this
increase in emissions and limit the possibility of thermal damage, the ECM monitors the misfire rate. When
the temperature of the catalyst reaches a point of thermal degradation, the ECM will blink the MIL. For monitoring misfires, the ECM uses both the camshaft position sensor and the crankshaft position sensor. The
camshaft position sensor is used to identify misfiring cylinders and the crankshaft position sensor is used
to measure variations in the crankshaft rotation speed. A misfire is counted when crankshaft rotation speed
variations exceed threshold values.
If the misfiring rate exceeds the threshold value and could cause emission deterioration, the ECM illuminates
the MIL.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
701
05-512
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
P0300
P0301
P0302
P0303
P0304
P0305
P0306
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Misfiring of random cylinders is detected
Open or short in engine wire
Connector connection
Vacuum hose connection
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel pressure
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Compression pressure
Valve clearance
Valve timing
PCV hose connection
PCV hose
ECM
Misfiring of each cylinder is detected
Open or short in engine wire
Connector connection
Vacuum hose connection
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel pressure
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Compression pressure
Valve clearance
Valve timing
PCV hose connection
PCV hose
ECM
HINT:
When several codes for a misfiring cylinder are recorded repeatedly but no random misfire code is recorded,
the misfires have been detected and recorded at different times.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
ECM
Camshaft Position Sensor
Crankshaft Position Sensor
(36-2 teeth or 12 teeth)
A87798
The ECM illuminates the MIL (2 trip detection logic) if:
The misfiring rate exceeds a threshold value and could cause emission deterioration.
During the first 1,000 engine revolutions after the engine starts, an excessive misfire rate (approximately 20 to 50 misfires per 1,000 engine revolutions) occurs 1 time.
After the first 1,000 engine revolutions after the engine starts, an excessive misfire rate (approximately
20 to 50 misfires per 1,000 engine revolutions) occurs 4 times.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
702
05-513
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
The ECM blinks the MIL (MIL blinks immediately) if:
Within 200 engine revolutions at a high rpm, the threshold for ”percentage of misfire causing catalyst
damage” is reached 1 time.
Within 200 engine revolutions at a normal rpm, the threshold for ”percentage of misfire causing catalyst
damage” is reached 3 times (for the 2nd trip, reaching the threshold once will cause the MIL to flash).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0300: Multiple Cylinder Misfire
P0301: Cylinder 1 Misfire
P0302: Cylinder 2 Misfire
P0303: Cylinder 3 Misfire
P0304: Cylinder 4 Misfire
P0305: Cylinder 5 Misfire
P0306: Cylinder 6 Misfire
Required sensors / components (Main)
Injector, Ignition coil, Spark plug
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP, CMP, ECT, IAT and MAF meter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
1,000 revolutions x 4: Emission-related-misfire
200 revolutions x 3: Catalyst-damaged-misfire
MIL operation
2 driving cycles: emission-related misfire
MIL flashes immediately: catalyst-damage misfire
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
VVT system
Not operated by scan tool
Engine RPM
450 to 5,900 rpm
All of the following conditions are met:
Condition 1, 2 and 3
1. Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT)
-10 C (14F) or more
2. Either of the following conditions is met
Condition (a) or (b)
(a) IAT
-10 C (14F) or more
(b) ECT
75C (167F) or more
3. Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition (a) or (b)
(a) ECT at engine start
More than -7C (19.4F)
(b) ECT
More than 20C (68F)
Fuel-cut
OFF
Monitor Period of Emission-related-misfire:
First 1,000 revolutions after engine start, or check mode
Crankshaft 1,000 revolutions
Except above
Crankshaft 1,000 revolutions × 4
Monitor Period of Catalyst-damage-misfire (MIL blinks):
All of the following conditions 1, 2 and 3 met:
Crankshaft 200 revolutions
1. Driving cycles
1st
2. Check Mode
OFF
3. Engine RPM
Less than 3,000 rpm
Except above
Crankshaft 200 revolutions x 3
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
703
05-514
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Monitor Period of Emission-related-misfire:
Misfire rate
1.0 % or more
Monitor Period of Catalyst-damage-misfire (MIL blinks):
Number of misfire per 200 revolutions
77 or more (varies with intake air amount and engine RPM)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
704
05-515
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0351 on page 05-541 for the wiring diagram of the ignition system.
I15
Ignition Switch
7
6
AM2
Y
ECM
I8
Injector No. 1
IG2
R
2
GR
L
1
#10
E7
Y
2
#20
E7
B
3
#30
E7
W
4
#40
E7
B-W
5
#50
E7
G
3
#60
E8
1
1 IC1
I9
Injector No. 2
Instrument
Panel J/B Assy
R
1 1C
2
1
9
1G
R
L-Y
I10
Injector No. 3
IG2
R
4 1C
1 1G
2
LG
1
B
R
I11
Injector No. 4
AM2
10
F7
FL Block Assy
1
R
6 IC3
R
2
1
R
I12
Injector No. 5
W
5 EB1
R
2
FL
Main
R
1
R
I13
Injector No. 6
R
2
1
Battery
A88693
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
705
05-516
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Record DTC and the freeze frame data.
Set the hand-held tester to check mode (see page 05-400 ).
Read the value on the misfire counter for each cylinder when idling. If the value is displayed on the
misfire counter, skip the following procedure of confirmation driving.
(e) Drive the vehicle several times with the engine speed, load and its surrounding range shown with ENGINE SPD, CALC LOAD in the freeze frame data or MISFIRE RPM, MISFIRE LOAD in the DATA LIST.
If you have no hand-held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after the symptom is simulated once. Then repeat the simulation process again.
HINT:
In order to memorize the misfire DTC, it is necessary to drive with MISFIRE RPM, MISFIRE LOAD in the
DATA LIST for the period of time in the chart below. Take care not to turn the ignition switch OFF. Turning
the ignition switch OFF switches the diagnosis system from check mode to normal mode and all DTCs,
freeze frame data and other data are erased.
(f)
(g)
Engine Speed
Time
Idling
3 minutes 30 seconds or more
1,000 rpm
3 minutes or more
2,000 rpm
1 minute 30 seconds or more
3,000 rpm
1 minute or more
Check if there is misfire and DTC and the freeze frame data. Record the DTC’s, freeze frame date and
misfire counter data.
Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait for at least 5 seconds.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs besides misfire DTCs are memorized simultaneously, troubleshoot the non-misfire DTCs first.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, it is useful for determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air-fuel ratio
was lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
If the misfire does not occur when the vehicle is brought to the workshop, the misfire can be confirmed
by reproducing the condition of the freeze frame data. Also, after finishing the repair, confirm that there
is no misfire (see confirmation driving pattern).
On 6 and 8 cylinder engines, cylinder specific misfire fault codes are disabled at high engine speeds.If
the misfire starts in a high engine speed area or the misfire occurs only in a high engine speed area,
only the general fault code P0300 will be stored.
When only a general misfire fault code like P0300 is stored:
(1) Erase the general misfire fault code from the ECM using the hand-held tester or OBD II scan
tool.
(2) Start the engine and drive the confirmation patten.
(3) Read the value of the misfire ratio for each cylinder. Or read the DTC.
(4) Perform repairs on the cylinder that has a high misfire ratio. Or repair the cylinder indicated by
the DTC.
(5) After finishing repairs, drive the confirmation pattern again and confirm that no misfire occurs.
When either of SHORT FT #1, LONG FT #1, SHORT FT #2 or LONG FT #2 in the freeze frame data
is over the range of ±20 %, there is a possibility that the air-fuel ratio is becoming RICH (-20 % or
less) or LEAN (+20 % or more).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
706
05-517
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
When COOLANT TEMP in the freeze frame data is less than 80°C (176°F), there is a possibility of
misfire only during engine warm-up.
If the misfire cannot be reproduced, the following reasons may apply: 1) the vehicle has low fuel, 2)
improper fuel is being used, and 3) the ignition plug is contaminated.
Be sure to check the value on the misfire counter after the repair.
1
(a)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO MISFIRE DTCS)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
Only P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305 and/or P0306 are output
A
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305 or P0306 and other DTCs are
output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305 or P0306 are output, perform the
troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-412 )
A
2
(a)
(b)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS, CONNECTOR AND VACUUM HOSE IN ENGINE ROOM
Check the connection conditions of the wire harness and connector.
Check for the disconnection, piping and break of the vacuum hose.
OK: Connected correctly and no damage ON wire harness.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE, THEN CONFIRM THAT
THERE IS NO MISFIRE
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTION OF PCV HOSE
OK: PCV hose is connected correctly. And PCV hose has no damage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
707
05-518
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (NUMBER OF
MISFIRE)
(a) Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
(c) Start the engine.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / CYL#1 to CYL#6.
(e) Read the number of misfires on the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
HINT:
When a misfire is not reproduced, be sure to branch below based on the stored DTC.
Result:
High Misfire Rate Cylinder
Proceed to
1 or 2 cylinders
A
More than 3 cylinders
B
B
Go to step 15
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
708
05-519
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK SPARK PLUG AND SPARK OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
Base of the
Ground Electrode
(a)
(b)
(c)
Remove the ignition coil.
Remove the spark plug.
Check the spark plug type.
Recommended spark plug:
DENSO made
SK20R11
NGK made
IFR6A11
(d)
1.0 to 1.1 mm
(0.039 to 0.043 in.)
B02101
B04941
A74353
Check the spark plug electrode gap.
Standard: 1.0 to 1.1 mm (0.039 to 0.043 in.)
Maximum: 1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
NOTICE:
If adjusting the gap of a new spark plug, bend only the base
of the ground electrode. Do not touch the tip. Never attempt
to adjust the gap on a used plug.
(e) Check the electrode for carbon deposits.
(f)
Perform a spark test.
CAUTION:
Always disconnect each injector connector.
NOTICE:
Do not crank the engine for more than 2 seconds.
(1) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil and connect
the ignition coil connector.
(2) Disconnect the injector connector.
(3) Ground the spark plug.
(4) Check if spark occurs while the engine is being
cranked.
OK: Spark jumps across electrode gap.
OK
Go to step 8
NG
6
CHANGE NORMAL SPARK PLUG AND CHECK SPARK OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(a) Change to a normal spark plug.
(b) Perform a spark test.
CAUTION:
Always disconnect each injector connector.
NOTICE:
Do not crank the engine for more than 2 seconds.
(1) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil and connect the ignition coil connector.
(2) Disconnect the injector connector.
(3) Ground the spark plug.
(4) Check if spark occurs while the engine is being cranked.
OK: Spark jumps across electrode gap.
OK
REPLACE SPARK PLUG
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
709
05-520
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (IGNITION COIL - ECM)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
I2 I3
I4 I5
I6 I7
Ignition Coil
Check the wire harness between the ignition coil and
ECM.
(1) Disconnect the I2, I3, I4, I5, I6 and I7 ignition coil
connector.
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
I2-2
I3-2
I4-2
I5-2
I6-2
I7-2
E7
ECM
A85513
(b)
Wire Harness Side
I2 I3
I4 I5
I6 I7
Ignition Coil
IGT5
Y
A54393
A81699
Specified Condition
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
Check the wire harness between the ignition coil and
ECM.
(1) Disconnect the I2, I3, I4, I5, I6 and I7 ignition coil
connector.
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I2-3 - E7-8 (IGT1)
I3-3 - E7-9 (IGT2)
I4-3 - E7-10 (IGT3)
I5-3 - E7-11 (IGT4)
I6-3 - E7-12 (IGT5)
I7-3 - E7-13 (IGT6)
Below 1 Ω
I2-3 or E7-8 (IGT1) - Body ground
I3-3 or E7-9 (IGT2) - Body ground
I4-3 or E7-10 (IGT3) - Body ground
I5-3 or E7-11 (IGT4) - Body ground
I6-3 or E7-12 (IGT5) - Body ground
I7-3 or E7-13 (IGT6) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E7
ECM
IGT6
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
I2-2 or E7-24 (IGF1) - Body ground
I3-2 or E7-24 (IGF1) - Body ground
I4-2 or E7-24 (IGF1) - Body ground
I5-2 or E7-24 (IGF1) - Body ground
I6-2 or E7-24 (IGF1) - Body ground
I7-2 or E7-24 (IGF1) - Body ground
IGF1
Y
A54393
A81699
-
IGT1
IGT2
IGT3
IGT4
A85513
OK
REPLACE IGNITION COIL ASSY (THEN CONFIRM THAT THERE IS NO MISFIRE)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
710
05-521
DIAGNOSTICS
8
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM TERMINAL OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (#10, #20, #30, #40, #50, #60
VOLTAGE)
#40 (+)
#50 (+)
#30 (+)
#10 (+)
#20 (+)
#60 (+)
(a)
(b)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
E01 (-)
E7
ECM
E8
ECM
E7-1
E7-2
E7-3
E7-4
E7-5
E8-3
A76903
(#10)
(#20)
(#30)
(#40)
(#50)
(#60)
-
E7-7
E7-7
E7-7
E7-7
E7-7
E7-7
Specified Condition
(E01)
(E01)
(E01)
(E01)
(E01)
(E01)
9 to 14 V
HINT:
Reference: Inspection using the oscilloscope.
During cranking or idling, check the waveform between the terminals of the ECM connector.
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
#1 to #6 - E01
Engine idling
Connect waveform is as shown
Injector Signal Waveform
(Magnification)
20 V
/Division
20 V
/Division
GND
GND
Injection duration 1 msec./Division (Idling)
100 msec./Division (Idling)
A78423
OK
Go to step 11
NG
9
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR RESISTANCE OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(See page 11-41 )
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
(See page 11-46 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
711
05-522
DIAGNOSTICS
10
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (INJECTOR - ECM, INJECTOR
- IGNITION SWITCH)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
I8 I9
I10 I11
I12 I13
Injector
E7
ECM
#40
-
E8
ECM
#30 #20 #10
#60
#50
Y
A72872
A76789
Check the wire harness between the injector and ECM.
(1) Disconnect the I8, I9, I10, I11, I12 and I13 injector
connectors.
(2) Disconnect the E7 or E8 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I8-1 - E7-1 (#10)
I9-1 - E7-2 (#20)
I10-1 - E7-3 (#30)
I11-1 - E7-4 (#40)
I12-1 - E7-5 (#50)
I13-1 - E8-3 (#60)
Below 1 Ω
I8-1 or E7-1 (#10) - Body ground
I9-1 or E7-2 (#20) - Body ground
I10-1 or E7-3 (#30) - Body ground
I11-1 or E7-4 (#40) - Body ground
I12-1 or E7-5 (#50) - Body ground
I13-1 or E8-3 (#60) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A85844
(b)
Instrument
Panel
J/B Assy
Check the IG2 fuse.
(1) Remove the IG2 fuse from the instrument panel J/B.
(2) Check the resistance of the IG2 fuse.
OK: Below 1 Ω
IG2 Fuse
A90345
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
712
05-523
DIAGNOSTICS
(c)
Wire Harness Side
I7 I8
I10 I11
I12 I13
Injector
2
6
3
7
4
8
IG2
Y
A72872
A85676
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Check the wire harness between the injector and ignition
switch.
(1) Disconnect the I8, I9, I10, I11, I12 and I13 injector
connector.
(2) Disconnect the I15 ignition switch connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
I15
Ignition Switch
1
5
-
A88566
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I8-2 - I15-6 (IG2)
I9-2 - I15-6 (IG2)
I10-2 - I15-6 (IG2)
I11-2 - I15-6 (IG2)
I12-2 - I15-6 (IG2)
I13-2 - I15-6 (IG2)
Below 1 Ω
I8-2 or I15-6 (IG2) - Body ground
I9-2 or I15-6 (IG2) - Body ground
I10-2 or I15-6 (IG2) - Body ground
I11-2 or I15-6 (IG2) - Body ground
I12-2 or I15-6 (IG2) - Body ground
I13-2 or I15-6 (IG2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
11
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR INJECTION AND VOLUME OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(See page 11-41 )
Standard:
Injection volume
Difference between each injector
60 to 73 cm3 (3.7 to 4.5 cu in.) per 15 seconds
13 cm3 (0.8 cu in.) or less
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
OK
12
CHECK CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(See page 14-121 )
Standard:
Compression pressure:
1.5 MPa (15.3 kgf/cm2, 218 psi)
Minimum pressure:
1.0 MPa (10.2 kgf/cm2, 145 psi)
Difference between each cylinder:
100 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 15 psi)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
713
05-524
DIAGNOSTICS
13
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK VALVE CLEARANCE OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (See page 14-127 )
Standard (cold):
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
0.15 to 0.25 mm (0.059 to 0.0098 in.)
Exhaust
0.25 to 0.35 mm (0.098 to 0.00138 in.)
NG
ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(See page 14-127 )
OK
14
SWITCH STEP BY NUMBER OF MISFIRE CYLINDER (REFER TO RESULTS OF
STEP 4)
HINT:
If the result of step 4 is ”1 or 2 cylinders”, proceed to A.
If the result of step 4 is ”more than 3 cylinders”, proceed to B.
B
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
A
15
CHECK VALVE TIMING (CHECK FOR LOOSENESS OR A JUMPED TOOTH OF THE
TIMING BELT) (See page 14-206 )
OK: The matchmarks of crankshaft pulley and camshaft pulley are aligning.
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING (See page 14-206 )
(REPAIR OR REPLACE TIMING BELT)
OK
16
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE (See page 11-38 )
Standard:
Fuel pressure: 304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 55 psi).
NG
CHECK
AND
REPLACE
FUEL
PUMP,
PRESSURE REGULATOR, FUEL PIPE LINE AND
FILTER
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
714
05-525
DIAGNOSTICS
17
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (INTAKE AIR
TEMPERATURE AND MASS AIR FLOW RATE)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the intake air temperature.
(1) On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / INTAKE AIR. Read the values.
Temperature: Equivalent to ambient temperature.
Check the air flow rate.
(1) On the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / MAF. Read the values.
Standard:
(d)
Condition
Air Flow Rate (gm/s)
Ignition switch ON (do not start engine)
0
Idling
4 to 6
Running without load (2,500 rpm)
13 to 20
Idling to quickly accelerating
Air flow rate fluctuates
NG
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
OK
18
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
Ohmmeter
30
20
Resistance KΩ
10
5
Acceptable
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
-20
S01196
S01699
(-4)
0
20 40 60 80 100
(32) (68) (104) (140) (176) (212)
Temperature C (F)
A81700
Remove the ECT sensor.
Measure the resistance between the terminals of the sensor.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
20C (68F)
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ
1-2
80C (176F)
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ
NOTICE:
If of checking the ECT sensor in the water, be careful not to
allow water to contact the terminals. After the check, dry
the sensor.
HINT:
Alternate procedure: Connect an ohmmeter to the installed
ECT sensor and read the resistance. Use an infrared thermometer to measure the engine temperature in the immediate vicinity of the sensor. Compare these values to the resistance/temperature graph. Change the engine temperature (warm up or
allow to cool down) and repeat the test.
NG
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
715
05-526
DIAGNOSTICS
19
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
SWITCH STEP BY NUMBER OF MISFIRE CYLINDER (REFER TO RESULTS OF
STEP 4)
HINT:
If the result of step 4 is ”1 or 2 cylinders”, proceed to A.
If the result of step 4 is ”more than 3 cylinders”, proceed to B.
B
AGAIN GO TO STEP 5
A
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS (See page 05-370 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
716
05-527
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05MOO-01
DTC
P0327
KNOCK SENSOR 1 CIRCUIT LOW INPUT
(BANK 1 OR SINGLE SENSOR)
DTC
P0328
KNOCK SENSOR 1 CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
(BANK 1 OR SINGLE SENSOR)
DTC
P0332
KNOCK SENSOR 2 CIRCUIT LOW INPUT
(BANK 2)
DTC
P0333
KNOCK SENSOR 2 CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
(BANK 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A flat type knock sensor (non-resonant type) can detect vibrations in a wide band of frequency (about 6 kHz
to 15 kHz) and has the following features:
Knock sensors are fitted on the cylinder block to detect the engine knocking.
The sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage, when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine knocking occurs, the ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0327
P0332
Output voltage of the knock sensor 1 or 2 is 0.5 V or less
(1 trip detection logic)
Short in knock sensor 1 or 2 circuit
Knock sensor 1 or 2
ECM
P0328
P0333
Output voltage of the knock sensor 1 or 2 is 4.5 V or more
(1 trip detection logic)
Open in knock sensor 1 or 2 circuit
Knock sensor 1 or 2
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The knock sensor, located on the cylinder block, detects spark knock. When spark knock occurs, the sensor
picks up vibrations in a specific frequency range. When the ECM detects the voltage in this frequency range,
it retards the ignition timing to suppress the spark knock.
The ECM also senses background engine noise with the knock sensor and uses this noise to check for faults
in the sensor. If the knock sensor signal level is too low for more than 10 seconds, and if the knock sensor
output voltage is out of normal range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the knock sensor and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0327: Knock Sensor (Bank 1) Range Check (Low voltage)
P0328: Knock Sensor (Bank 1) Range Check (High voltage)
P0332: Knock Sensor (Bank 2) Range Check (Low voltage)
P0333: Knock Sensor (Bank 2) Range Check (High voltage)
Required sensors / components (Main)
Knock Sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
MAF meter, CKP sensor, ECT sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
1 second
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
717
05-528
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Knock Sensor Range Check P0327, P0328, P0332, P0330:
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Time after engine start
5 seconds or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Knock Sensor Range Check (Low voltage) P0327, P0332:
Knock sensor Voltage
Less than 0.5 V
Knock Sensor Range Check (High voltage) P0328, P0333:
Knock sensor voltage
More than 4.5 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
K2
Knock Sensor 1
1
Shielded
B
KNK1
1
EA1
W
28
E8
EKNK
4
EA1
R
2
E8
KNK2
3
EA1
G
20
E8
EKN2
2 B
W
K3
Knock Sensor 2
1
2 R
G
5V
1
E8
2
EA1
Shielded
5V
A
BR
ED
A
A
J7
J/C
A87844
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
DTC P0327 and P0328 are for the bank 1 knock sensor circuit.
DTC P0332 and P0333 are for the bank 2 knock sensor circuit.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
718
05-529
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
READ OUTPUT DTC (CHECK KNOCK SENSOR CIRCUIT)
EA1
Knock Sensor
1
2
1
2
ECM
2
2
1
1
4
4
3
3
Male
Connector
EA1
1
E8
28
E8
2
E8
20
E8
(a)
(b)
Disconnect the EA1 connector.
Using lead wires, connect the EA1 terminals as follows.
Male Connector - Female Connector
KNK1
Terminal 2 - Terminal 4
EKNK
Terminal 1 - Terminal 3
KNK2
Terminal 4 - Terminal 2
EKN2
Terminal 3 - Terminal 1
Female
Connector
(c)
(d)
(e)
Warm up the engine.
Run the engine at 3,000 rpm for 10 seconds or more.
Check the DTC.
Result:
A87795
B
Display
Proceed to
DTC same as when vehicle brought in
P0327, P0328 → P0327, P0328
or
P0332, P0333 → P0332, P0333
A
DTC different from when vehicle brought in
P0327, P0328 → P0332, P0333
or
P0332, P0333 → P0327, P0328
B
Go to step 4
A
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (EA1 CONNECTOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
EA1
Female Connector
E8
ECM
KNK2
Disconnect the EA1 connector.
Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 of EA1 female connector - E8-1 (KNK1)
1 of EA1 female connector - E8-28 (EKNK)
4 of EA1 female connector 4 - E8-2 (KNK2)
3 of EA1 female connector - E8-20 (EKN2)
Below 1 Ω
2 of EA1 female connector or E8-1 (KNK1) - Body ground
1 of EA1 female connector or E8-28 (EKNK) - Body ground
4 of EA1 female connector or E8-2 (KNK2) - Body ground
3 of EA1 female connector or E8-20 (EKN2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
KNK1
EKN2
EKNK
A88585
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
719
05-530
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM
KNK2
(a)
(b)
(c)
KNK1
Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the ECM terminals.
Voltage:
EKN2
EKNK
E8
ECM
Specified Condition
E8-1 (KNK1) - E8-28 (EKNK)
E8-2 (KNK2) - E8-20 (EKN2)
4.5 to 5.5 V
A76969
KNK1 and KNK2 Signal Waveform
1V / DIV
GND
1 msec./ Division
Tester Connection
A85286
HINT:
Reference: Inspection using the oscilloscope.
After warming up, run the engine at 4,000 rpm, and check the
waveform of the ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E8-1 (KNK1) - E8-28 (EKNK)
E8-2 (KNK2) - E8-20 (EKN2)
Correct waveform is as shown
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS (See page 05-370 )
NOTICE:
Fault may be intermittent. Check harness and connectors carefully and retest.
4
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR
(a)
(b)
Wire Harness Side
EA1
Male Connector
A73938
Disconnect the EA1 connector.
Check the resistance between the terminals of the EA1
male connector.
Standard:
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 - 1 of EA1 male connector
4 - 3 of EA1 male connector
120 to 280 kΩ
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
720
05-531
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
HINT:
Wire Harness Side
(a)
(b)
(c)
EA1
Male Connector
If DTC P0327 has changed to P0328, or if DTC P0332
has changed to P0333, check the knock sensor circuit on
the bank 1 side.
If DTC P0332 has changed to P0327, or if DTC P0333
has changed to P0338, check the knock sensor circuit on
the bank 2 side.
Disconnect the EA1 connector.
Disconnect the K2 or K3 knock sensor connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 of EA1 male connector - K2-2
1 of EA1 male connector - K2-1
4 of EA1 male connector - K3-2
3 of EA1 male connector - K3-1
Below 1 Ω
2 of EA1 male connector or K2-2 - Body ground
1 of EA1 male connector or K2-1 - Body ground
4 of EA1 male connector or K3-2 - Body ground
3 of EA1 male connector or K3-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
1 2
Y
A73938
A610.31
K2 (Bank 1)
K3 (Bank 2)
Knock Sensor
A85847
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE KNOCK SENSOR (See page 10-20 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
721
05-532
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXT-05
DTC
P0335
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ”A”
CIRCUIT
DTC
P0339
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ”A”
CIRCUIT INTERMITTENT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft position (CKP) sensor system consists of a crankshaft position sensor plate and a pickup
coil. The sensor plate has 34 teeth and is installed on the crankshaft. The pickup coil is made of an iron core
and magnet. The sensor plate rotates and as each tooth passes through the pickup coil, a pulse signal is
generated. The pickup coil generates 34 signals for each engine revolution. Based on these signals, the
ECM calculates the crankshaft position and engine RPM. Using these calculations, the fuel injection time
and ignition timing are controlled.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0335
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM during cranking
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Crankshaft timing pulley
ECM
P0335
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM with engine
speed 600 rpm or more (2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Crankshaft timing pulley
ECM
P0339
No crankshaft position sensor signal is input to ECM for 0.05
seconds. or more, and conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met:
(a) Engine is at 1,000 rpm or more
(b) STA signal is OFF
(c) 3 seconds or more have elapsed after STA signal is
switched from ON to OFF
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Crankshaft timing pulley
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is no signal from the crankshaft sensor even though the engine is cranking, the ECM interprets this
as a malfunction of the sensor.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0335: CKP Sensor Range Check during Cranking
P0335: CKP Sensor Range Check during Engine Running
Required sensors / components (Main)
CKP (Crankshaft position) sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
4.7 seconds: CKP Sensor Range Check during Cranking
0.016 seconds: CKP Sensor Range Check during Engine Running
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
CKP Sensor Range Check during Cranking P0335:
Starter
ON
Minimum battery voltage while starter is ON
Below 11 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
722
05-533
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CKP Sensor Check during Engine Running P0335:
Engine RPM
600 rpm or more
Starter
OFF
Time after starter turns from ON to OFF
3 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
CKP signal
No signal
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
CKP sensor voltage fluctuates when the crankshaft rotates 34 CKP signals per 1
revolution crankshaft
CKP signal
WIRING DIAGRAM
V7
VVT Sensor RH (Bank 1)
ECM
Shielded
B-W
1
27
E9
VV1+
26
E9
VV2+
25
E9
NE+
24
E9
NE-
L
2
V6
VVT Sensor LH (Bank 2)
Shielded
L
1
R
2
C7
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Shielded
R
1
G
G
2
A
A
G
J7
J/C
A
BR
A
ED
A88687
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Read values on the hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool.
(a) Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
(b) Start the engine and push the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool main switch ON.
(c) Select the item ”DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL / ENGINE SPD”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
723
05-534
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
The engine speed can be confirmed in DATA LIST using the hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool. If
there are no NE signals from the crankshaft position sensor despite the engine revolving, the engine
speed will be indicated as zero. If voltage output of the crankshaft position sensor is insufficient, the
engine speed will be indicated as lower than the actual rpm.
1
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
A64984
E9
ECM
NEVV1+
VV2+
Disconnect the C7 sensor connector.
Measure the resistance between the terminals of the sensor.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Cold
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
1-2
Hot
2,065 to 3,225 Ω
NOTICE:
In the above section, the terms ”cold” and ”hot” refer to the
temperature of the coils. ”Cold” means approximately
-10 C to 50C (14F to 122F). ”Hot” means approximately
50C to 100C (122F to 212F).
HINT:
Reference: Inspection using the oscilloscope.
During cranking or idling, check the waveform of the ECM connector.
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-27 (VV1+) - E9-24 (NE-)
E9-26 (VV2+) - E9-24 (NE-)
E9-25 (NE+) - E9-24 (NE-)
Correct waveform is as shown
NE+
VV1, VV2 and NE Signal Waveforms
2 V/
Division
VV1
GND
VV2
GND
NE
GND
20 msec./Division (Idling)
A88569
NG
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(See page 18-9 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
724
05-535
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
Disconnect the C7 sensor connector.
Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
C7
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C7-1 - E9-25 (NE+)
C7-2 - E9-24 (NE-)
Below 1 Ω
C7-1 or E9-25 (NE+) - Body ground
C7-2 or E9-24 (NE-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E9
ECM
NENE+
Y
A54385
A81699
A85533
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
(a)
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR)
Check the crankshaft position sensor installation.
OK: Sensor is installed correctly.
NG
TIGHTEN SENSOR
OK
4
(a)
CHECK CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Check the teeth of the crankshaft timing pulley.
OK: The pulley does not have any cracks or deformation.
NG
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
725
05-536
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXU-05
DTC
P0340
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ”A”
CIRCUIT (BANK 1 OR SINGLE SENSOR)
DTC
P0341
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ”A”
CIRCUIT RANGE/PERFORMANCE (BANK 1
OR SINGLE SENSOR)
DTC
P0345
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ”A”
CIRCUIT (BANK 2)
DTC
P0346
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ”A”
CIRCUIT RANGE/PERFORMANCE (BANK 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Variable Valve Timing (VVT) sensor (VV signal) consists of a magnet, iron core and pickup coil.
The VV signal plate has 3 teeth on its outer circumference and is installed on the camshaft timing pulley.
When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the signal plate and the air gap on the pickup coil change,
causing fluctuations in the magnetic field and generating a voltage in the pickup coil.
This sensor monitors a timing rotor located on the camshaft and is used to detect camshaft angle by the
ECM. The camshaft rotation synchronizes with the crankshaft rotation, and this sensor communicates the
rotation of the camshaft timing rotor as a pulse signal to the ECM. Based on the signal, the ECM controls
fuel injection time and ignition timing.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0340
P0345
No VVT sensor signal to ECM during cranking (2 trip detection logic)
No VVT sensor signal to ECM with engine speed 600 rpm or
more (1 trip detection logic)
Open or short in VVT sensor circuit
VVT sensor
Camshaft timing pulley
Timing belt has a jumped tooth
ECM
P0341
While crankshaft rotates twice, VVT sensor signal is input to
ECM 12 times or more (1 trip detection logic)
HINT: Under normal condition, the camshaft position sensor
signal is input into the ECM 3 times per 2 engine revolutions.
Open or short in VVT sensor circuit
VVT sensor
Camshaft timing pulley
Timing belt has a jumped tooth
ECM
P0346
While crankshaft rotates twice, VVT sensor signal is input to
EMC 5 times or more. (1 trip detection logic)
HINT: Under normal condition, the camshaft position sensor
signal is input into the ECM 3 times per 2 engine revolutions.
Open or short in VVT sensor circuit
VVT sensor
Camshaft timing pulley
Timing belt has a jumped tooth
ECM
HINT:
DTC P0340 and P0345 indicate a malfunction related to the VVT sensor (+) circuit
(Wire harness (ECM - VVT sensor) and VVT sensor).
DTC P0341 and P0346 indicate a malfunction related to the VVT sensor (-) circuit
(Wire harness (ECM - VVT sensor) and VVT sensor).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
726
05-537
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is no signal from the VVT sensor even though the engine is cranking, or if the rotations of the camshaft
and the crankshaft are not synchronized, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction of the sensor.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0340: CMP Sensor (Bank 1) Range Check
P0340: CMP/CKP Misalignment (Bank 1)
P0341: CMP Sensor (Bank 1) Malfunction
P0345: VVT Sensor (Bank 2) Range Check (Case 1)
P0345: VVT Sensor (Bank 2) Range Check (Case 2)
P0346: VVT Sensor (Bank 2) Malfunction
Required sensors / components (Main)
CMP (Crankshaft position) sensor VVT sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
5 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles: CMP Sensor Range Check
VVT Sensor Range Check (Case 1)
Immediate: Others
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
CMP Sensor Range Check P0340:
Starter
ON
Minimum battery voltage while starter is ON
Less than 11V
CMP/CKP Misalignment P0340:
Engine RPM
600 rpm or more
Starter
OFF
VVT Sensor Range Check P0345 (Case 1):
Starter
ON
Minimum battery voltage while starter is ON
Less than 11V
VVT Sensor Range Check P0345 (Case 2):
Engine RPM
600 rpm or more
Starter
OFF
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
CMP Sensor Range Check P0340:
CMP signal
No signal
CMP/CKP Misalignment P0340:
Alignment is judged using CMP-CKP input timing
CMP sensor signal input in appropriate timing
No signal
CMP Sensor (Bank 1) Malfunction P0341:
CMP and CKP phase
Misaligned
CMP signal per 2 revolutions crankshaft
12 CMP signals or more
VVT Sensor Range Check P0345 (Case 1):
VVT sensor signal
No signal
VVT Sensor Range Check P0345 (Case 2):
VVT sensor signal
No signal
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
727
05-538
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
VVT Sensor (Bank 2) Malfunction P0346:
VVT sensor signal count
12 signals or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
CMP sensor signal
CMP sensor voltage fluctuates when the crankshaft rotates
3 CMP signals per 2 revolutions of crankshaft
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 on page 05-532 .
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
728
05-539
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT VVT SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
A64984
E9
ECM
NEVV1+
VV2+
Disconnect the V7 or V6 VVT sensor connector.
Measure the resistance between the terminals of the VVT
sensor.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Cold
835 to 1,400 Ω
1-2
Hot
1,060 to 1,645 Ω
NOTICE:
In the above section, the terms ”cold” and ”hot” refer to the
temperature of the coils. ”Cold” means approximately
-10 C to 50C (14F to 122F). ”Hot” means approximately
50C to 100C (122F to 212F).
HINT:
Reference: Inspection using the oscilloscope.
During cranking or idling, check the waveform of the ECM connector.
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E9-27 (VV1+) - E9-24 (NE-)
E9-26 (VV2+) - E9-24 (NE-)
E9-25 (NE+) - E9-24 (NE-)
Correct waveform is as shown
NE+
VV1, VV2 and NE Signal Waveforms
2 V/
Division
VV1
GND
VV2
GND
NE
GND
20 msec./Division (Idling)
A88569
NG
REPLACE VVT SENSOR (See page 18-1 1)
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
729
05-540
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (VVT SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
V7 (Bank 1)
V6 (Bank 2)
VVT Sensor
Disconnect the V7 or V6 VVT sensor connector.
Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-1 - E9-27 (VV1+)
V6-1 - E9-26 (VV2+)
V6 or V7-2 - E9-24 (NE-)
Below 1 Ω
V7-1 or E9-27 (VV1+) - Body ground
V6 -1 or E9-26 (VV2+) - Body ground
2 of V6 or V7 or E9-24 (NE-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E9
ECM
NEVV1+
VV2+
Y
A54385
A81699
A85533
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
(a)
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION (VVT SENSOR)
Check the sensor installation.
OK: Sensor is installed correctly.
NG
TIGHTEN SENSOR
OK
4
(a)
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Check the teeth of the camshaft timing pulley.
OK: The pulley does not have any cracks or deformation.
NG
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
730
05-541
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXE-05
DTC
P0351
IGNITION COIL ”A” PRIMARY/SECONDARY
CIRCUIT
DTC
P0352
IGNITION COIL ”B” PRIMARY/SECONDARY
CIRCUIT
DTC
P0353
IGNITION COIL ”C” PRIMARY/SECONDARY
CIRCUIT
DTC
P0354
IGNITION COIL ”D” PRIMARY/SECONDARY
CIRCUIT
DTC
P0355
IGNITION COIL ”E” PRIMARY/SECONDARY
CIRCUIT
DTC
P0356
IGNITION COIL ”F” PRIMARY/SECONDARY
CIRCUIT
HINT:
These DTCs indicate a malfunction related to primary circuit.
If DTC P0351 is displayed, check No. 1 ignition coil with igniter
If DTC P0352 is displayed, check No. 2 ignition coil with igniter
If DTC P0353 is displayed, check No. 3 ignition coil with igniter
If DTC P0354 is displayed, check No. 4 ignition coil with igniter
If DTC P0355 is displayed, check No. 5 ignition coil with igniter
If DTC P0356 is displayed, check No. 6 ignition coil with igniter
circuit.
circuit.
circuit.
circuit.
circuit.
circuit.
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A Direct Ignition System (DIS) is used on this vehicle.
The DIS is a 1-cylinder ignition system which ignites one cylinder with one ignition coil. In the 1-cylinder
ignition system, the one spark plug is connected to the end of the secondary winding. High voltage generated
in the secondary winding is applied directly to the spark plug. The spark of the spark plug passes from the
center electrode to the ground electrode.
The ECM determines the ignition timing and outputs the ignition signals (IGTs) for each cylinder. Using the
IGT, the ECM turns on and off the power transistor inside the igniter, which switches on and off current to
the primary coil. When current to the primary coil is cut off, high-voltage is generated in the secondary coil
and this voltage is applied to the spark plugs to create sparks inside the cylinders. As the ECM cuts the current to the primary coil, the igniter sends back the ignition confirmation signal (IGF) for each cylinder ignition
to the ECM.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
731
05-542
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
From Battery
ECM
Igniter
No.1 Ignition Coil with Igniter
IGT1
No. 1 Cylinder
IGF1
Crankshaft
Position
Sensor
Ignition Coil
IGT2
No. 2 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
No. 2 Cylinder
IGT3
No. 3 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
No. 3 Cylinder
IGT4
No. 4 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
No. 4 Cylinder
IGT5
No. 5 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
No. 5 Cylinder
IGT6
No. 6 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
No. 6 Cylinder
VVT
Sensor
Other Sensors
ECT Sensor
MAF Meter
Throttle Position Sensor
Others
Spark Plug
TACH
To Tachometer
A82677
DTC No.
P0351
P0352
P0353
P0354
P0355
P0356
DTC Detection Condition
No IGF signal to ECM while engine is running
(1 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF1 and IGT circuits (1 through 6) from
ignition coil assy to ECM
Ignition coil assy (No. 1 through No. 6)
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
732
05-543
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Ignition Coil with Igniter
IGT
ECM
Ignition Coil
Igniter
IGF
Ignition Signal
(IGT)
Ignition
Confirmation
Signal (IGF)
Normal
Malfunction
Circuit Open
time
A82388
If the ECM does not receive the IGF after sending the IGT, it interprets this as a fault in the igniter and sets
a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0351: Igniter (Cylinder 1) malfunction
P0352: Igniter (Cylinder 2) malfunction
P0353: Igniter (Cylinder 3) malfunction
P0354: Igniter (Cylinder 4) malfunction
P0355: Igniter (Cylinder 5) malfunction
P0356: Igniter (Cylinder 6) malfunction
Required sensors / components (Main)
Igniter
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.256 seconds + 6 sparks
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Engine RPM
1,500 rpm or less
2. Starter
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
IGF signal
ECM does not detect IGF signal from igniter when ECM sends IGT signal to igniter
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
733
05-544
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
IGF signal
Igniter outputs IGF signal when it receives IGT signal from ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
I15
Ignition Switch
I2
Ignition Coil Assy No. 1
7 AM2
R
IG2 6
1
Y
W-B
IC1 1
4
GR
+B
IGT
GND IGF
3
W-R
R
1
W-B
6
1F
4
R
1
W-B
4
R
IGT
GND IGF
R
1 IC3
1
W-B
10
AM2
F7
FL Block
Assy
BR
4
R
IGT2
W-R
2
+B
IGT
GND IGF
+B
IGT
GND IGF
10
E7
Y-B
3
IGT3
W-R
2
W-R
11
E7
L-Y
3
IGT4
W-R
2
Ignition Coil Assy No. 5
R
1
W
W-B
BR
4
R
+B
IGT
GND IGF
FL
Main
W-B
N1
Noise
Filter
R
1
R
+B
IGT
4
W-B
EC
GND IGF
IGT5
W-R
2
W-R
L-R
3
W-B
1
12
E7
3
Ignition Coil Assy No. 6
R
W-R
G-Y
I7
Battery
IGF1
I6
W-B
2 EB1
1
9
E7
3
Ignition Coil Assy No. 4
W-B
IGT1
W-R
P
I5
L-Y
W-R
24
E7
W-R
R
O
4
S29
Ignition Coil Assy No. 3
W-B
1 1G 4 1C
B
+B
I4
IG2
4
S28
Short Connector
Ignition Coil Assy No. 2
1 1C
W-R
2
I3
Instrument
Panel J/B Assy
8
E7
R-L
BR
A
2
13
E7
1 IGT6
E9 E1
J7
J/C
A BR
ED
A88694
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
734
05-545
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK SPARK PLUG AND SPARK OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (See page 18-9 )
OK: Spark occurs.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (IGNITION COIL ASSY - ECM (IGF1 TERMINAL)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
(b)
(c)
I2 I3
I4 I5
I6 I7
Ignition Coil
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4, I5, I6 and I7 ignition coil connectors.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
I2-2
I3-2
I4-2
I5-2
I6-2
I7-2
E7
ECM
I2-2
I3-2
I4-2
I5-2
I6-2
I7-2
or
or
or
or
or
or
-
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
E7-24
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
(IGF1)
-
Body
Body
Body
Body
Body
Body
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
ground
ground
ground
ground
ground
ground
10 kΩ or higher
IGF1
Y
A54393
A81699
A85848
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
735
05-546
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK ECM (IGF VOLTAGE)
(a)
IGF1 (+)
E1 (-)
(b)
(c)
E7
ECM
E9
ECM
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4, I5, I6 and I7 ignition coil connectors.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Measure the voltage between the terminals of the ECM
connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-24 (IGF1) - E9-1 (E1)
4.5 to 5.5 V
A76903
HINT:
Reference: Inspection using the oscilloscope.
During cranking or idling, check the waveform of the ECM connectors.
IGF 1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-24 (IGF1) - E9-1 (E1)
Correct waveform is as shown
E1 (-)
E7
ECM
E9
ECM
IGF Signal Waveform
2 V/
Division
CH2
GND
20 msec./Division
A88572
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
REPLACE IGNITION COIL ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
736
05-547
DIAGNOSTICS
4
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (IGNITION COIL ASSY - ECM (IGT TERMINAL))
(a)
Wire Harness Side
(b)
(c)
I2 I3
I4 I5
I6 I7
Ignition Coil
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4, I5, I6 and I7 ignition coil connectors.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
E7
ECM
IGT6
IGT5
Y
A54393
A81699
-
IGT1
IGT2
IGT3
IGT4
A85848
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I2-3 - E7-8 (IGT1)
I3-3 - E7-9 (IGT2)
I4-3 - E7-10 (IGT3)
I5-3 - E7-11 (IGT4)
I6-3 - E7-12 (IGT5)
I7-3 - E7-13 (IGT6)
Below 1 Ω
I2-3 or E7-8 (IGT1) - Body ground
I3-3 or E7-9 (IGT2) - Body ground
I4-3 or E7-10 (IGT3) - Body ground
I5-3 or E7-1 (1IGT4) - Body ground
I6-3 or E7-12 (IGT5) - Body ground
I7-3 or E7-13 (IGT6) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
737
05-548
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK ECM (IGT1, IGT2, IGT3, IGT4, IGT5 OR IGT6 VOLTAGE)
IGT5 (+)
IGT3 (+)
IGT 6 (+) IGT4 (+)
IGT1 (+)
IGT2 (+)
(a)
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors when the engine is cranked.
Standard:
E1 (-)
E7
ECM
IGT5 (+)
E9
ECM
A76903
(b)
IGT3 (+)
IGT 6 (+) IGT4 (+)
IGT2 (+)
IGT1 (+)
(c)
IGT5 (+)
A76903
IGT3 (+)
IGT 6 (+) IGT4 (+)
IGT2 (+)
IGT1 (+)
More than 0.1 V or
less than 4.5 V
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-8 (IGT1) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-9 (IGT2) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-10 (IGT3) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-1 1 (IGT4) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-12 (IGT5) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-13 (IGT6) - E9-1 (E1)
4.5 V or more
HINT:
Reference: Inspection using the oscilloscope.
During cranking or idling, check the waveform of the ECM connectors.
E1 (-)
E7
ECM
Specified Condition
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4, I5, I6 and I7 ignition coil connectors.
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors when the engine is cranked.
Standard:
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
E7
ECM
Tester Connection
E7-8 (GT1) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-9 (IGT2) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-10 (IGT3) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-1 1 (IGT4) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-12 (IGT5) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-13 (IGT6) - E9-1 (E1)
E9
ECM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-8 (GT1) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-9 (IGT2) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-10 (IGT3) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-1 1 (IGT4) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-12 (IGT5) - E9-1 (E1)
E7-13 (IGT6) - E9-1 (E1)
Correct waveform is as shown
IGT Signal Waveform
2 V/
Division
CH1
GND
20 msec./Division
A88572
NG
REPLACE ECM
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
738
05-549
DIAGNOSTICS
6
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT IGNITION COIL ASSY (POWER SOURCE)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
(b)
(c)
I2 I3
I4 I5
I6 I7
Ignition Coil
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4, I5, I6 and I7 ignition coil connectors.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
I2-1
I3-1
I4-1
I5-1
I6-1
I7-1
A54393
OK
-
Body
Body
Body
Body
Body
Body
Specified Condition
ground
ground
ground
ground
ground
ground
9 to 14 V
REPLACE IGNITION COIL ASSY
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
739
05-550
DIAGNOSTICS
7
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (IGNITION COIL ASSY - IGNITION SWITCH)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
Instrument
Panel J/B
Assy
IG2 Fuse
(b)
(c)
(d)
Check the IG2 fuse.
(1) Remove the IG2 fuse from the instrument panel J/B
assy.
(2) Check for resistance of the IG2 fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
Disconnect the I2, I3, I4, I5, I6 and I7 ignition coil connectors.
Disconnect the II5 ignition switch connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
I2 I3
I4 I5
I6 I7
Ignition Coil
I2-1
I3-1
I4-1
I5-1
I6-1
I7-1
I15
Ignition Switch
1
5
2
6
3
7
or
or
or
or
or
or
I2-1
I3-1
I4-1
I5-1
I6-1
I7-1
-
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
I15-6
(IG2)
(IG2)
(IG2)
(IG2)
(IG2)
(IG2)
-
Specified Condition
(IG2)
(IG2)
(IG2)
(IG2)
(IG2)
(IG2)
Body
Body
Body
Body
Body
Body
Below 1 Ω
ground
ground
ground
ground
ground
ground
10 kΩ or higher
4
8
IG2
A92540
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE IGNITION COIL ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
740
05-551
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05BNU-11
DTC
P0420
CATALYST SYSTEM EFFICIENCY BELOW
THRESHOLD (BANK 1)
DTC
P0430
CATALYST SYSTEM EFFICIENCY BELOW
THRESHOLD (BANK 2)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses sensors mounted before and after the Three-Way Catalyst (TWC) to monitor its efficiency.
The first sensor, an Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor 1, sends pre-catalyst A/F ratio information to the ECM. The
second sensor, a heated oxygen sensor (O2S) sends post-catalyst information to the ECM. The ECM
compares these two signals to judge the efficiency of the catalyst and the catalyst’s ability to store oxygen.
During normal operation, the TWC stores and releases oxygen as needed. The capacity to store oxygen
results in a low variation in the post-TWC exhaust stream as shown below.
If the catalyst is functioning normally, the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor slowly switches between
RICH and LEAN. If the catalyst is deteriorated, the waveform will alternate frequently between RICH and
LEAN. As the catalyst efficiency degrades, its ability to store oxygen is reduced and the catalyst output becomes more variable.
When running the monitor, the ECM compares sensor 1 signals (A/F sensor) over a specific amount of time
to determine catalyst efficiency. The ECM begins by calculating the signal length for both sensors (for the
rear oxygen sensor, the ECM uses the output voltage signal length). If the oxygen sensor output voltage
signal length is greater than the threshold (threshold is calculated based on the A/F sensor signal length),
the ECM concludes that the catalyst is malfunctioning. The ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC will be set.
Normal Catalyst
Waveform of A/F Sensor
Before Catalyst
1.0 V
3.5 V
Waveform of Heated Oxygen Sensor
After Catalyst
3.0 V
0V
10 seconds
Deteriorated Catalyst
Waveform of A/F Sensor
Before Catalyst
3.5 V
1.0 V
Waveform of Heated Oxygen Sensor
After Catalyst
3.0 V
0V
10 seconds
A85838
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
741
05-552
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Heated Oxygen Sensor Signal Length
Signal Length
Sensor
Output
Voltage
Time
A82718
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0420
After engine and catalyst are warmed up, and while vehicle is
driven within set vehicle and engine speed ranges:
Waveform of heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) alternates frequently between RICH and LEAN (2 trip detection
logic)
Gas leakage in exhaust system
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Three-way catalytic converter (exhaust manifold)
P0430
After engine and catalyst are warmed up, and while vehicle is
driven within set vehicle and engine speed ranges:
Waveform of heated oxygen sensor (bank 2 sensor 2) alternates frequently between RICH and LEAN (2 trip detection
logic)
Gas leakage in exhaust system
A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 2 sensor 2)
Three-way catalytic converter (exhaust manifold)
HINT:
Bank 1 is the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
Bank 2 is the bank that does not include cylinder No. 1.
Sensor 1 is the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
Sensor 2 is the sensor farthest away from the engine assembly.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0420: Catalyst (Bank 1) Deterioration
P0430: Catalyst (Bank 2) Deterioration
Required sensors / components (Main)
Catalyst
Required sensors / components (Related)
A/F sensor, Rear HO2S, IAT sensor, MAF meter, CKP sensor, ECT sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
150 seconds (30 seconds x 5)
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
742
05-553
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-377
Accumulated time that all of the following conditions are met:
30 seconds
Battery voltage
11 V or more
IAT
-10 C (14F) or more
Idle
OFF
MAF
6 to 45 g/second
Engine RPM
Less than 3,000 rpm
ECT
75C (167F) or more
Fuel system status
Closed Loop
Rich experience after fuel cut
Yes
A/F sensor
Activated
Estimated catalyst temperature
Both of the following conditions 1 and 2 are met
1. Upstream catalyst temperature
500 to 800C (932 to 1472F)
2. Downstream catalyst temperature
500 to 800C (932 to 1472F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Rear HO2S locus length
15 V or more (Varies with A/F sensor locus length)
Frequency of the monitor
3 times
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-385 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-387 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $01: Catalyst - Sensor 1 A/F sensor, Sensor 2 HO2S
TLT
CID
Unit Conversion
Description of Test Data
0
$01
Multiply by 0.0078
(no dimension)
Catalyst deterioration level (bank 1):
Determined by waveforms of A/F sensor
and HO2S 2
0
$02
Multiply by 0.0078
(no dimension)
Catalyst deterioration level (bank 2):
Determined by waveforms of A/F sensor
and HO2S 2
Description of Test Limit
Malfunction criteria for catalyst deterioration
Malfunction criteria for catalyst deterioration
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
743
05-554
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CONDITIONING A/F SENSOR AND HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR FOR TESTING
Engine Speed
(c)
(d)
3,000 rpm
2,000 rpm
Idling
(a)
IG SW OFF
(b)
Time
Warmed up
3 min. or so
2 sec. 2 sec.
Check
A00479
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessories switched OFF until the ECT is stable.
Run the engine at 2,500 to 3,000 rpm for about 3 minutes.
When alternating the engine between 3,000 rpm and 2,000 rpm for 2 seconds respectively, check the
waveform of the oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0420 AND/OR P0430)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
Only P0420 and/or P0430 are output
A
P0420 or P0430 and other DTCs are output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0420 and/or P0430 are output, perform the troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-412 )
A
2
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
OK: No gas leakage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
LEAKAGE POINT
EXHAUST
GAS
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
744
05-555
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (See page 12-23 )
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
4
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (See page 05-485 )
OK: During air-fuel ratio feedback, the O2S’s output alternates between rich and lean.
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OK
REPLACE THREE-WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER (EXHAUST MANIFOLD LH OR RH AND FRONT
EXHAUST PIPE)
NOTICE:
On the damaged bank, replace both the front catalyst and rear catalyst.
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
The following procedure enables the technician to identify a trouble area if malfunction in A/F sensors
front or rear heated oxygen sensors other than the catalyst converter, or the malfunction that indicates
the actual air-fuel ratio extremely RICH or LEAN.
It is possible the malfunctioning area can be found using the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
The A/F CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential
trouble areas are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume 12.5 % or increases the injection volume 25 %.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Warm up the engine by running the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(5) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine idle (press the right or left button).
Result:
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume
+25 % → rich output: More than 0.5 V
-12.5 % → lean output: Less than 0.4 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
745
05-556
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Output voltage of A/F sensor
(sensor 1)
Output voltage of heated oxygen
sensor (sensor 2)
Injection volume
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 1 Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
OK
More than 0.55 V
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 2 Output voltage
A/F sensor
(A/F sensor, heater, A/F sensor circuit)
Output voltage
NG
Injection volume
More than 0.55 V
OK
Less than 0.4V
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 3 Output voltage
Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
OK
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
NG
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 4 Output voltage
Almost
No reaction
OK
Less than 0.4V
+25 %
Less than 3.0V
Output voltage
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Mainly suspected
Trouble Area
Output voltage
NG
Almost
No reaction
NG
Heated oxygen sensor
(heated oxygen sensor,
heater, heated oxygen sensor
circuit)
Extremely rich or lean actual
air-fuel ratio
(Injector, fuel pressure, gas
leakage in exhaust system,
etc.)
The following of A/F CONTROL procedure enables the technician to check and graph the voltage outputs
of both the heated oxygen sensors.
For displaying the graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2” by pressing ”YES” and push ”ENTER”. Then press ”F4”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
746
05-557
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0441
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05MOP-01
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL
SYSTEM INCORRECT PURGE FLOW
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the EVAP INSPECTION PROCEDURE (see page 05-679 ).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP INSPECTION PROCEDURE (see page 05-679 ).
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM tests the Evaporative Emissions (EVAP) system using the fuel tank pressure sensor, Canister
Close Valve (CCV), and EVAP VSV. The ECM closes the EVAP system and creates negative pressure (vacuum) into it. The ECM then monitors the internal pressure using the fuel tank pressure sensor.
P0441
The EVAP VSV has the following features:
(1) Purges the evaporative emissions from the fuel tank to the intake manifold.
(2) Works with the CCV to create negative pressure (vacuum) inside the fuel tank and performs leak
tests.
Opening or closing malfunctions in the EVAP VSV prompt the ECM to set DTC P0441.
The ECM checks if the EVAP VSV is ”stuck closed”. The ECM commands the EVAP VSV to open while the
CCV is closed. Under these circumstances, a high negative pressure(vacuum) should develop in the fuel
tank. If no negative pressure develops, the ECM determines that the EVAP VSV remains closed despite the
open command. The ECM would then turn on the MIL and output a DTC.
The ECM also checks if the EVAP VSV is ”stuck open”. The ECM commands the EVAP VSV to close while
the CCV is closed and the fuel tank is at ambient pressure. Under these circumstances, the fuel tank should
remain at ambient pressure. If negative pressure develops in the fuel tank, the ECM determines that the
EVAP VSV remains open despite the close command. The ECM would then turn on the MIL and output a
DTC.
DTC No.
P0441
DTC Detection Condition
Pressure in charcoal canister and fuel tank does not drop
during purge control (2 trip detection logic)
During purge cut-off, negative is pressure entering charcoal
canister and fuel tank (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Vacuum hose has cracks, holes, or is blocked, damaged or
disconnected
Fuel tank cap incorrectly installed
Fuel tank cap has cracks or is damaged
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
Open or short in EVAP VSV circuit
EVAP VSV
Open or short in CCV circuit
CCV
Fuel tank has cracks, holes, or is damaged
Charcoal canister has cracks, holes, or is damaged
Fuel tank over fill check valve cracks, or is damaged
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
747
05-558
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Intake Air
Air Cleaner Case
Throttle
Valve
Intake Manifold
Charcoal Filter
Air Cleaner Filter
When EVAP VSV is opened, partial vacuum is created
Leak Detection Area
Purge Line
EVAP VSV
(Purge Valve)
ECM
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
Diaphragm
(Atmospheric Pressure)
Fuel Tank Cap
Restrictor
Passage
EVAP Line
Fuel Tank
EVAP Service
Port
Purge Line
Charcoal
Canister
When CCV is
opened, air is
drawn or released
Charcoal Canister Filter
CCV
Air Inlet Line
A76973
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
748
05-559
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
VSV Malfunction Condition and Leak Check
EVAP VSV is Open: ON
CCV is Open: OFF
VSV Operation
Normal driving
Leak check (same as next page)
Open
Open
Close
EVAP VSV
Open
Open
CCV
Close
Pressure in Fuel Tank
Atmospheric
Pressure
Normal Condition or
EVAP System Leak
(Normal Pressure Line)
(See next page for details)
Normal
Leak
EVAP VSV
Close Malfunction
(P0441)
DTC Detection
Timing
EVAP VSV
Open Malfunction
(P0441)
DTC Detection
Timing
CCV Open
Malfunction
(P0446)
DTC Detection
Timing
CCV Close
Malfunction
(P0446)
DTC Detection Timing
A85438
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
749
05-560
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Leak Check
Initial Condition:
Cold start
Engine coolant temperature/intake air temperature are nearly the same
Ambient Pressure
FTP:
Pressure in
Fuel Tank
(Vapor
Pressure)
Gross Leak
(P0455)
(for ex., Fuel Tank
Cap loose)
(for ex., Disconnected
Vacuum Hose)
Start of
Creation of
Negat ive
Pressure
Small Leak
(P0442)
Very Small Leak
(P0456)
Normal Pressure
Rise
Open*1
EVAP VSV
(Operation)
Closed
Closed
Open*2
CCV
(Operation)
Open
Closed
P0455
Creation of
Partial
Vacuum
P0442, P0456
Tank & Canister
Vacuum is Relieved
Leak Check
(DTC Detection Period)
*1: EVAP VSV is Open: ON
*2: CCV is Open: OFF
A85439
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
750
05-561
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0441: Purge VSV stuck open
P0441: purge VSV stuck close
Required sensors / components (Main)
CCV, EVAP canister, EVAP hose, Fuel cap, Fuel tank and Purge VSV
Required sensors / components (Related)
ECT sensor, FTP sensor, IAT sensor, MAF meter, Vehicle speed sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 60 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Altitude
Less than 7,870 ft. (2,400 m)
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
IAT at engine start - ECT at engine start
-7 to 11.1C (-12.6 to 20F)
EVAP VSV and CCV
Not operated test by scan tool
Either of the following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. Purge duty cycle
8% or more (vary with MAF)
2. Purge concentration for 30 seconds
-5 %/% or more when vehicle speed is less than 10 km/h (6.25 mph)
Refuel
Not refueled with engine running
FTP
12.75 mmHg (-1.7 kPa) or more
ECT at engine start
4.4 to 35C (39.9 to 95F)
IAT at engine start
4.4 to 35C (39.9 to 95F)
IAT
4.4C (39.9F) or more
Vehicle speed change
Vehicle is driven by steady speed
Fuel slosh
No sloshing (i.e. fairly smooth road)
Time after engine start
Within 50 minutes
FTP change before vacuum introduction
Minimum change
Fuel level
Less than 90 %
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Purge VSV stuck close P0441:
FTP change during vacuum introduction
Less than 5.25 mmHg (0.7 kPa)
Purge VSV stuck open P0441:
Duration that of the following condition is met
4 seconds or more
FTP before vacuum introduction
Less than -10 mmHg (-1.333 kPa)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
751
05-562
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-385 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-387 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $02: EVAP system - LEV ll Vacuum monitor
TLT
CID
Unit Conversion
Description of Test Data
Description of Test Limit
1
$01
Multiply by 0.183
(mmHg)
Test value of EVAP VSV stuck close:
Determined by fuel tank pressure change
during vacuum introduction
0
$02
Multiply by 0.0655
(seconds)
Test value of EVAP VSV stuck open:
Determined by duration that fuel tank pressure is higher than criteria
Malfunction criteria for EVAP VSV stuck
open
0
$03
Multiply by 0.0655
(seconds)
Test value of canister closed valve (CCV):
Determined by duration that fuel tank pressure is lower than criteria
Malfunction criteria for Canister Closed
Valve (CCV)
0
$04
Multiply by 0.0458
(mmHg)
Test value 0.04 inch leak:
Determined by fuel tank pressure change
Malfunction criteria for 0.04 inch leak
0
$05
Multiply by 0.0458
(mmHg)
Test value 0.02 inch leak:
Determined by fuel tank pressure change
Malfunction criteria for 0.02 inch leak
Malfunction criteria for EVAP VSV stuck
closed
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
752
05-563
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05MOQ-01
DTC
P0442
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL
SYSTEM LEAK DETECTED (SMALL LEAK)
DTC
P0455
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL
SYSTEM LEAK DETECTED (GROSS LEAK)
DTC
P0456
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL
SYSTEM LEAK DETECTED (VERY SMALL
LEAK)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the EVAP INSPECTION PROCEDURE (see page 05-679 ).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP INSPECTION PROCEDURE (see page 05-679 ).
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM tests the Evaporative Emissions (EVAP) system using the fuel tank pressure sensor, Canister
Close Valve (CCV), and EVAP VSV. The ECM closes the EVAP system and creates negative pressure (vacuum) into it. The ECM then monitors the internal pressure using the fuel tank pressure sensor (refer to the
Leak Check graphic).
P0442, P0455 and P0456
A leak in the evaporative emission system prompts the ECM to set DTC P0442, P0455 or P0456.
The ECM checks if the EVAP has leaks. First, the ECM opens the EVAP VSV while the CCV is closed. After
a sufficient amount of time has passed, a high negative pressure(vacuum) will develop in the fuel tank as
air is drawn into the intake manifold. The EVAP VSV is then closed. The ECM then monitors the pressure
increase (loss of vacuum) in the fuel tank. If the pressure rises beyond a specified amount, the ECM determines that the system has a leak, turns on the MIL and outputs a DTC.
The ECM has separate DTCs for small and large leaks:
(1) DTC P0442 is set when the internal fuel tank pressure has a large increase and the EVAP system
has a small leak.
(2) DTC P0455 is set when the EVAP system has a very large leak. The ECM tries to create negative
pressure (vacuum) in the fuel tank by opening the EVAP VSV while the CCV is closed. However,
the fuel tank pressure does not decrease beyond a specified threshold.
(3) DTC P0456 is set when the internal fuel tank pressure increases slightly and the EVAP system
has a very small leak.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
753
05-564
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
P0442
P0455
P0456
Cold engine start.
EVAP VSV has been operated and turned OFF, sealing negative pressure (vacuum) in system.
ECM begins to monitor fuel tank pressure increase and one
of the following occurs (2 trip detection logic):
(a) Rapid, sharp increase in pressure occurs, indicating small
leak in EVAP system. DTC P0442 is set.
(b) Negative pressure (vacuum) is not strong enough, indicating large hole in EVAP system. DTC P0455 is set.
(c) Increase in pressure above expected amount occurs, indicating small leak in EVAP system. DTC P0456 is set.
Trouble Area
Vacuum hose has cracks, holes, or is blocked, damaged or
disconnected
Fuel tank cap incorrectly installed
Fuel tank cap has cracks or is damaged
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
Open or short in EVAP VSV circuit
EVAP VSV
Open or short in CCV circuit
CCV
Fuel tank has cracks, holes, or is damaged
Charcoal canister has cracks, holes, or is damaged
Fuel tank over fill check valve cracks, or is damaged
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
754
05-565
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Intake Air
Air Cleaner Case
Throttle
Valve
Intake Manifold
Charcoal Filter
Air Cleaner Filter
When EVAP VSV is opened, partial vacuum is created
Leak Detection Area
Purge Line
EVAP VSV
(Purge Valve)
ECM
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
Diaphragm
(Atmospheric Pressure)
Fuel Tank Cap
Restrictor
Passage
EVAP Line
Fuel Tank
EVAP Service
Port
Purge Line
Charcoal
Canister
When CCV is
opened, air is
drawn or released
Charcoal Canister Filter
CCV
Air Inlet Line
A76973
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
755
05-566
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
VSV Malfunction Condition and Leak Check
EVAP VSV is Open: ON
CCV is Open: OFF
VSV Operation
Leak check (same as next page)
Normal driving
Open
Open
Close
EVAP VSV
Open
Open
CCV
Close
Pressure in Fuel Tank
Atmospheric
Pressure
Normal Condition or
EVAP System Leak
(Normal Pressure Line)
(See next page for details)
Normal
Leak
EVAP VSV
Close Malfunction
(P0441)
DTC Detection
Timing
EVAP VSV
Open Malfunction
(P0441)
DTC Detection
Timing
CCV Open
Malfunction
(P0446)
DTC Detection
Timing
CCV Close
Malfunction
(P0446)
DTC Detection Timing
A85438
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
756
05-567
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Leak Check
Initial Condition:
Cold start
Engine coolant temperature/intake air temperature are nearly the same
Ambient Pressure
FTP:
Pressure in
Fuel Tank
(Vapor
Pressure)
Gross Leak
(P0455)
(for ex., Fuel Tank
Cap loose)
(for ex., disconnect of
Vacuum Hose)
Start of
Creation of
Negat ive
Pressure
Small Leak
(P0442)
Very Small Leak
(P0456)
Normal Pressure
Rise
EVAP VSV
(Operation)
Open*1
Closed
Closed
Open*2
CCV
(Operation)
Open
Closed
P0455
Creation of
Partial
Vacuum
P0442, P0456
Tank & Canister
Vacuum is Relieved
Leak Check
(DTC Detection Period)
*1: EVAP VSV is Open: ON
*2: CCV is Open: OFF
A85439
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
757
05-568
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0442: EVAP 0.04 inch leak
P0455: EVAP gross leak
P0456: EVAP 0.02 inch leak
Required sensors / components (Main)
CCV, EVAP canister, EVAP hose, Fuel cap, Fuel tank and Purge VSV
Required sensors / components (Related)
ECT sensor, FTP sensor, IAT sensor, MAF meter, Vehicle speed sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 90 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Altitude
Less than 7,870 ft. (2,400 m)
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
IAT at engine start - ECT at engine start
-7 to 11.1C (-12.6 to 20F)
EVAP VSV and CCV
Not operated test by scan tool
Either of the following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. Purge duty cycle
8% or more (vary with MAF)
2. Purge concentration for 30 seconds
-5 %/% or more when vehicle speed is less than 10 km/h (6.25 mph)
Refuel
Not refueled with engine running
FTP
12.75 mmHg (-1.7 kPa) or more
EVAP 0.02 inch leak P0456:
ECT at engine start
4.4 to 32C (39.9 to 89.6F)
IAT at engine start
4.4 to 32C (39.9 to 89.6F)
IAT
4.4C (39.9F) or more
Vehicle speed change
Vehicle is driven by steady speed
Fuel slosh
No sloshing (i.e. fairly smooth road)
Time after engine start
Within 50 minutes
FTP change before vacuum introduction
Minimum change
Fuel level
Less than 90 %
0.04 inch leak
Not detected
CCV malfunction
Not detected
Vehicle speed
Less than 81.25 mph (130 km/h)
Purge VSV malfunction
Not detected
Others:
ECT at engine start
4.4 to 35C (39.9 to 95F)
IAT at engine start
4.4 to 35C (39.9 to 95F)
IAT
4.4C (39.9F) or more
Vehicle speed change
Vehicle is driven by steady speed
Fuel slosh
No sloshing (i.e. fairly smooth road)
Time after engine start
Within 50 minutes
FTP change before vacuum introduction
Minimum change
Fuel level
Less than 90 %
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
758
05-569
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
EVAP 0.04 inch leak P0442:
Both of the following conditions are met:
Condition 1 and 2
1. FTP change for 5 seconds from -20 mmHg (-2.67 kPa)
1.3 mmHg (0.17 kPa) or more
2. FTP change for 5 seconds from -17 mmHg (-2.27 kPa)
1.3 mmHg (0.17 kPa) or more
EVAP 0.02 inch leak P0456:
Both of the following conditions are met:
Condition 1 and 2
1. FTP change for 5 seconds when FTP is -17 mmHg
(-2.27 kPa)
0.7 mmHg (0.09 kPa) or more
2. FTP change for 5 seconds when FTP is -20 mmHg
(-2.67 kPa)
0.7 mmHg (0.09 kPa) or more
EVAP gross leak P0455:
FTP when vacuum introduction compleated
1.3 mmHg (0.17 kPa) or more
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-385 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-387 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $02: EVAP system - LEV ll Vacuum monitor
TLT
CID
Unit Conversion
Description of Test Data
Description of Test Limit
1
$01
Multiply by 0.183
(mmHg)
Test value of EVAP VSV stuck close:
Determined by fuel tank pressure change
during vacuum introduction
0
$02
Multiply by 0.0655
(seconds)
Test value of EVAP VSV stuck open:
Determined by duration that fuel tank pressure is higher than criteria
Malfunction criteria for EVAP VSV stuck
open
0
$03
Multiply by 0.0655
(seconds)
Test value of canister closed valve (CCV):
Determined by duration that fuel tank pressure is lower than criteria
Malfunction criteria for Canister Closed
Valve (CCV)
0
$04
Multiply by 0.0458
(mmHg)
Test value 0.04 inch leak:
Determined by fuel tank pressure change
Malfunction criteria for 0.04 inch leak
0
$05
Multiply by 0.0458
(mmHg)
Test value 0.02 inch leak:
Determined by fuel tank pressure change
Malfunction criteria for 0.02 inch leak
Malfunction criteria for EVAP VSV stuck
closed
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
759
05-570
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0446
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05MOR-01
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL
SYSTEM VENT CONTROL CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The circuit description can be found in the EVAP INSPECTION PROCEDURE (see page 05-679 ).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to the EVAP INSPECTION PROCEDURE (see page 05-679 ).
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM tests the Evaporative Emissions (EVAP) system using the fuel tank pressure sensor, Canister
Close Valve (CCV), and EVAP VSV. The ECM closes the EVAP system and creates negative pressure (vacuum) into it. The ECM then monitors the internal pressure using the fuel tank pressure sensor (refer to the
graphic on page 05-557 ).
P0446 (FOR SYSTEM DIAGRAM AND DTC DETECTION TIMING CHART, REFER TO DTC P0441
(see page 05-557 ))
The CCV is open under normal conditions. The CCV has the following features:
(1) After the EVAP VSV purges the EVAP from the fuel tank into the intake manifold, the CCV draws
fumes from the fuel tank into the charcoal canister.
(2) Relieves pressure inside the fuel tank when the pressure has suddenly risen.
(3) Along with the EVAP VSV, creates negative pressure (vacuum) inside the fuel tank and performs
leak tests.
The ECM checks if the CCV is ”stuck closed”. The ECM commands the CCV to open while the EVAP VSV
is open. If high negative pressure (vacuum) develops in the fuel tank and stays for more than 4 seconds,
the ECM determines that the CCV remains closed despite the open command. The ECM would then turn
on the MIL and output a DTC. The engine coolant temperature is not related to the output of this DTC.
The ECM also has a method for checking if the CCV is ”stuck open”. The ECM commands the CCV to close
while the EVAP VSV is open. If a sufficient amount of negative pressure dose not develop in the fuel tank,
the ECM determines that the CCV remains open despite the close command. The ECM would then turn on
the MIL and output a DTC.
DTC No.
P0446
DTC Detection Condition
Open or close malfunction in CCV (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Vacuum hose has cracks, holes, or is blocked, damaged or
disconnected
Fuel tank cap incorrectly installed
Fuel tank cap has cracks or is damaged
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
Open or short in EVAP VSV circuit
EVAP VSV
Open or short in CCV circuit
CCV
Fuel tank has cracks, holes, or is damaged
Charcoal canister has cracks, holes, or is damaged
Fuel tank over fill check valve cracks, or is damaged
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
760
05-571
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0446: CCV stuck open
P0446: CCV stuck close
Required sensors / components (Main)
CCV, EVAP canister, EVAP hose, Fuel cap, Fuel tank and Purge VSV
Required sensors / components (Related)
ECT sensor, FTP sensor, IAT sensor, MAF meter, Vehicle speed sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 60 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Altitude
Less than 7,870 ft. (2,400 m)
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
IAT at engine start - ECT at engine start
-7 to 11.1C (-12.6 to 20F)
EVAP VSV and CCV
Not operated test by scan tool
Either of the following conditions is met
Condition 1 or 2
1. Purge duty cycle
8% or more (vary with MAF)
2. Purge concentration for 30 seconds
-5 %/% or more when vehicle speed is less than 10 km/h (6.25 mph)
Refuel
Not refueled with engine running
FTP
12.75 mmHg (-1.7 kPa) or more
ECT at engine start
4.4 to 35C (39.9 to 95F)
IAT at engine start
4.4 to 35C (39.9 to 95F)
IAT
4.4C (39.9F) or more
Vehicle speed change
Vehicle is driven by steady speed
Fuel slosh
No sloshing (i.e. fairly smooth road)
Time after engine start
Within 50 minutes
FTP change before vacuum introduction
Minimum change
Fuel level
Less than 90 %
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
CCV stuck close P0446:
Duration that the following conditions 1 and 2 are met:
4 seconds or more
1. Accumulated purge volume
0.5 g or more
2. FTP
Less than -12.75 mmHg (-1.7 kPa)
CCV stuck open P0446:
Purge VSV stuck closed
Detected
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
761
05-572
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-385 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-387 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $02: EVAP system - LEV ll Vacuum monitor
TLT
CID
Unit Conversion
Description of Test Data
Description of Test Limit
1
$01
Multiply by 0.183
(mmHg)
Test value of EVAP VSV stuck close:
Determined by fuel tank pressure change
during vacuum introduction
0
$02
Multiply by 0.0655
(seconds)
Test value of EVAP VSV stuck open:
Determined by duration that fuel tank pressure is higher than criteria
Malfunction criteria for EVAP VSV stuck
open
0
$03
Multiply by 0.0655
(seconds)
Test value of canister closed valve (CCV):
Determined by duration that fuel tank pressure is lower than criteria
Malfunction criteria for Canister Closed
Valve (CCV)
0
$04
Multiply by 0.0458
(mmHg)
Test value 0.04 inch leak:
Determined by fuel tank pressure change
Malfunction criteria for 0.04 inch leak
0
$05
Multiply by 0.0458
(mmHg)
Test value 0.02 inch leak:
Determined by fuel tank pressure change
Malfunction criteria for 0.02 inch leak
Malfunction criteria for EVAP VSV stuck
closed
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
762
05-573
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXW-05
DTC
P0451
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL
SYSTEM PRESSURE SENSOR
RANGE/PERFORMANCE
DTC
P0452
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL
SYSTEM PRESSURE SENSOR/SWITCH
LOW INPUT
DTC
P0453
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL
SYSTEM PRESSURE SENSOR/SWITCH
HIGH INPUT
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
DTC ”P0451, P0452 or P0453” is recorded by the ECM when the vapor pressure sensor malfunctions.
P0451
The ECM monitors the vapor pressure sensor in two ways. One method examines the fluctuation of the electrical signal while the engine is idling. If the pressure signal varies beyond the specified range more than 7
times, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the vapor pressure sensor. The ECM also verifies that the pressure
signal changes within the specified range. If the output of the sensor does not vary for 5 minutes while the
intake air amount has been changing, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the vapor pressure sensor. DTC
P0451 will be set when either of the faults occurs and the ECM will turn on the MIL.
P0452 and P0453
When pressure indicated by the vapor pressure sensor deviates below -3.999 kPa (-30 mmHg) or above
1.999 kPa (15 mmHg), the ECM interprets this as a malfunction in the vapor pressure sensor. The ECM will
turn on the MIL and a DTC will be set.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
763
05-574
DIAGNOSTICS
Fig. 1
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Intake Air
Air Cleaner Case
Throttle
Valve
Intake Manifold
Charcoal Filter
When VSV for EVAP is opened, partial vacuum is created
Leak Detection Area
Purge Line
ECM
EVAP VSV
(purge valve)
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
Diaphragm
(Atmospheric Pressure)
Fuel Tank Cap
Restrictor
Passage
EVAP Line
Fuel Tank
EVAP Service
Port
Purge Line
Charcoal
Canister
When CCV is
opened, air is
drawn or released
Charcoal Canister Filter
CCV
Air Inlet Line
A76973
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
764
05-575
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0451
Vapor pressure sensor output changes extremely under these
conditions:
Vapor pressure sensor output changes often while vehicle
speed is 0 km/h (0 mph) and the engine is idling 5 to 10 seconds (2 trip detection logic)
Vapor pressure sensor output is stuck 5 minutes (2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
ECM
P0452
Vapor pressure sensor output remains less than -30 mmHg
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
ECM
P0453
Vapor pressure sensor output remains more than 15 mmHg
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0451: FTP Sensor Noise
P0451: FTP Sensor Stuck
P0452: FTP Sensor Range Check (Low voltage)
P0453: FTP Sensor Range Check (High voltage)
Required sensors / components (Main)
FTP sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
ECT sensor, IAT sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
7 seconds: FTP Sensor Range Check
45 seconds: FTP Sensor Noise
5 minutes: FTP Sensor Stuck
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
FTP Sensor Noise P0451:
Altitude
7,870 ft. (2,400 m) or less
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
FTP sensor malfunction (P0452, P0453)
Not detected
IAT at engine start - ECT at engine start
-7 to 11.1C (-12.6 to 20F)
EVAP VSV, CCV
Not operated by scan tool
ECT at engine start
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
IAT at engine start
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
FTP Sensor Stuck P0451:
Altitude
7,870 ft. (2,400 m) or less
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
FTP sensor malfunction (P0452, P0453)
Not detected
IAT at engine start - ECT at engine start
-7 to 11.1C (-12.6 to 20F)
EVAP VSV, CCV
Not operated by scan tool
ECT at engine start
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
IAT at engine start
4.4 to 35C (40 to 95F)
Time after engine start
5 seconds or more
0.04 inch leak
Not detected
0.02 inch leak
Not detected
CCV malfunction
Not detected
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
765
05-576
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
FTP Sensor Range Check P0452,P0453:
ECT at engine start
10 to 35C (50 to 95F)
IAT at engine start
10 to 35C (50 to 95F)
IAT at engine start - ECT at engine start
Less than 12C (21.6F)
Engine condition
Running
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
FTP Sensor Noise P0451:
Frequency that FTP change
6 times or more
FTP Sensor Stuck P0451:
FTP change
No change for 5 minutes
FTP Sensor Range Check (Low voltage) P0452:
FTP
Less than -30 mmHg (-3.999 kPa)
FTP Sensor Range Check (High voltage) P0453:
FTP
15 mmHg (1.999 kPa) or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
FTP
-26 to 11 mmHg (-3.5 to 1.5 kPa) or more [734 to 771 mmHg]
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to the EVAP INSPECTION PROCEDURE (see page 05-679 ).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs related to different system that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
Always troubleshoot DTCs P0441 (purge flow), P0446 (VSV for CCV), P0451, P0452 and P0453
(evaporative pressure sensor) before troubleshooting DTCs P0442, P0455 or P0456.
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, it is useful for determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air-fuel ratio
was lean or rich, etc. at the time the malfunction occured.
When the ENGINE RUN TIME in the freeze frame data is less than 200 seconds, carefully check the
vapor pressure sensor.
1
INSPECT ECM (VC VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
VC (+)
E7
ECM
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-18 (VC) - E7-28 (E2)
4.5 to 5.5 V
E2 (-)
A76903
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
766
05-577
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM (PTNK VOLTAGE)
E7
ECM
E5
ECM
E2 (-)
(a)
(b)
PTNK (+)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
(1) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vapor pressure sensor.
Standard (1):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-21 (PTNK) - E7-28 (E2)
2.9 to 3.7 V
(2)
Vapor Pressure Sendor
(1)
NOTICE:
The vacuum applied to the vapor pressure sensor must be
less than 66.7 kPa (500 mmHg, 19.7 in.Hg).
Standard (2):
(2)
No Vacuum
Using a MITYVAC (hand-held vacuum pump), apply a vacuum of 4.0 kPa (30 mmHg, 1.18 in.Hg) to
the vapor pressure sensor.
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-21 (PTNK) - E7-28 (E2)
0.5 V or less
Vacuum
A73688
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
V11
Vapor Pressure Sensor
GND
PTNK
VCC
E7
ECM
Disconnect the V11 vapor pressure sensor connector.
Disconnect the E5 and E7 ECM connectors.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V11-2 (PTNK) - E5-21 (PTNK)
V11-1 (GND) - E7-28 (E2)
V11-3 (VCC) - E7-18 (VC)
Below 1 Ω
V11-2 (PTNK) or E5-21 (PTNK) - Body ground
V11-3 (VCC) or E7-18 (VC) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E5
ECM
VC
PTNK
E2
A87823
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
767
05-578
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
059VM-21
DTC
P0500
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ”A”
DTC
P0503
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ”A”
INTERMITTENT/ERRATIC/HIGH
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) detects the wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the skid
control ECU. The skid control ECU converts these wheel speed signals into a 4-pulse signal and outputs
it to the ECM via the combination meter. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on the frequency
of these pulse signals.
4-Pulse
From
Speed Sensor
Skid
Control
ECU
4-Pulse
ECM
Combination
Meter
A79413
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0500
P0503
The ECM detects the following conditions simultaneously for 1
second (1 trip detection logic):
No SPD (VSS) signal is output when ECM detects NC (transmission counter gear) signal is more than 300 RPM.
PNP switch is OFF (When shift lever is in other than P and N
positions)
Open or short in VSS circuit
VSS
Combination meter
ECM
Skid control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM assumes that the vehicle is being driven when the transmission counter gear indicates more than
300 rpm and over 30 seconds have passed since the PNP switch was turned OFF. If there is no signal from
the vehicle speed sensor with these conditions satisfied, the ECM concludes that the vehicle speed sensor
is malfunctioning. The ECM will turn on the MIL and will set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0500: VSS Circuit
Required sensors / components (Main)
VSS, Combination meter, ABS ECU
Required sensors / components (Related)
Transmission counter gear Speed (CS) sensor, PNP switch, ECT sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
768
05-579
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Starter
OFF
Engine condition
Running
Transmission counter gear speed
300 rpm or more
Either of the following condition is met:
Condition 1 or 2
Condition 1
-
Engine coolant temperature
20C (68F) or more
ECT sensor
Not malfunction (P0115 or P0116)
Time after PNP switch turns from ON to OFF
2 seconds or more
Condition 2
-
Engine coolant temperature
ECT is less than 20C (68F)
ECT sensor
Malfunction (P0115 or P0116)
Time after PNP switch turns from ON to OFF
30 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
VSS signal
No pulse input
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
C12
Combination Meter
Center J/B
5V
W
13
9
1
3J
3B
9
Y
IL2
J7
J/C
A
A
Y
BR
17
SPD
E6
1
E7
E1
BR
ED
A85370
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
769
05-580
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a) Drive the vehicle and check if operation of the speedometer in the combination meter is normal.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is operating normally if the speedometer display is normal.
NG
CHECK SPEEDOMETER CIRCUIT
(See page 71-3 )
OK
2
INSPECT ECM (SPD VOLTAGE)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
SPD (+)
E6
ECM
Shift the lever to the neutral position.
Jack up the vehicle.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors as the wheel
is turned slowly.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E6-17 (SPD) - E9-1 (E1)
Generated intermittently
HINT:
The output voltage should fluctuate up and down similarly to the
diagram on the left when the wheel is turned slowly.
4.5
to 5.5 V
0V
Turn Wheel
A67446
A62954
A85537
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
770
05-581
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0504
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXF-05
BRAKE SWITCH ”A”/”B” CORRELATION
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
In addition to turning on the stop lamps, the stop lamp switch signals are used for a variety of engine, transmission, and suspension functions as well as being an input for diagnostic checks. It is important that the
switch operates properly, therefore this switch is designed with two complementary signal outputs: STP and
ST1-. The ECM analyzes these signal outputs to detect malfunctions in the stop lamp switch.
HINT:
Normal condition is as shown in the table.
DTC No.
P0504
Signal
Brake pedal released
In transition
Brake pedal depressed
STP
OFF
ON
ON
ST1-
ON
ON
OFF
DTC Detection Condition
Conditions (a), (b) and (c) continue for 0.5 seconds or more:
(a) Ignition switch ON
(b) Brake pedal released
(c) STP signal is OFF when the ST1- signal is OFF
Trouble Area
Short in stop lamp switch signal circuit
STOP fuse
Stop lamp switch
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
771
05-582
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
S15
Stop Lamp Switch Assy
Passenger Side J/B
3
4L
B
2
1
12
4M
ECM
BR
12
E6 ST1-
V
Y
P
3
4
J3
J/C
Passenger Side J/B
P
E
E
1
4E
4
4M
19
STP
E6
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
W
6
1G
1
1C
IGN
GR
STOP
1 1E
6
IG2
Instrument
Panel J/B Assy
I15
Ignition
AM2 Switch
1 1A
7
L-Y
B
2
1
1C1
Y
10
ALT
AM2
1
E7 E1
F7
FL Block Assy
BR
1
W
A
FL
Main
J7
J/C
A
BR
Battery
ED
A88696
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
772
05-583
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Hand-held tester:
1
(a)
CHECK STOP LAMP (OPERATION)
Check if the stop lamps turn on and off normally when the brake pedal is depressed and released.
OK: The stop lamps turn on when you depress the brake pedal.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH
CIRCUIT
OK
2
INSPECT STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
(a)
Free
Pushed in
2
4
1
Check the resistance of the switch terminals.
Standard:
Switch condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Switch pin free
1-2
Below 1 Ω
Switch pin free
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
1-2
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3
A82517
NG
REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
773
05-584
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (STP SIGNAL, ST1- VOLTAGE)
Brake Pedal
Depressed
(a)
(b)
Brake Pedal
Released
(c)
E1 (-)
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL /
STOP LIGHT SW. Read the values.
Standard:
Brake Pedal Condition
Specified Condition
Depressed
STP Signal ON
Released
STP Signal OFF
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
OK:
Tester Connection
ST1- (+)
Brake Pedal Condition
Specified Condition
Depressed
Below 1.5 V
Released
7.5 to 14 V
E6-12 (ST1-)
- E9-1 (E1)
E6-12 (ST1-)
- E9-1 (E1)
E9
ECM
E6
ECM
OK
A72880
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
NG
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STOP LAMP SWITCH - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
Disconnect the S15 stop lamp switch connector.
Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
S15
Stop Lamp Switch
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S15-1 - E6-19 (STP)
S15-4 - E6-12 (ST1-)
Below 1 Ω
S15-1 or E6-19 (STP) - Body ground
S15-4 or E6-12 (ST1-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E6
ECM
ST1Y
A56986
A67404
STP
NG
A87771
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
774
05-585
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
(a)
CHECK STOP LAMP (OPERATION)
Check if the stop lamps turn on and off normally when the brake pedal is depressed and released.
OK: The stop lamps turn on when you depress the brake pedal.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH
CIRCUIT
OK
2
INSPECT STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
(a)
Free
Pushed in
2
4
1
Check the resistance of the switch terminals.
Standard:
Switch condition
Tester Connection
Switch pin free
1-2
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
Switch pin free
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
1-2
10 kΩ or higher
Switch pin pushed in
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3
A82517
NG
REPLACE STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
775
05-586
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM (STP, ST1- VOLTAGE)
Brake Pedal
Depressed
(a)
(b)
Brake Pedal
Released
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Brake Pedal Condition
Specified Condition
E6-19 (STP) - E9-1 (E1)
Depressed
7.5 to 14 V
E6-19 (STP) - E9-1 (E1)
Released
Below 1.5 V
Depressed
Below 1.5 V
Released
7.5 to 14 V
E6-12 (ST1-)
- E9-1 (E1)
E6-12 (ST1-)
- E9-1 (E1)
E1 (-)
ST1- (+)
E9
ECM
STP (+)
E6
ECM
OK
A72880
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
NG
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STOP LAMP SWITCH - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
Disconnect the S15 stop lamp switch connector.
Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
S15
Stop Lamp Switch
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S15-1 - E6-19 (STP)
S15-4 - E6-12 (ST1-)
Below 1 Ω
S15-1 or E6-19 (STP) - Body ground
S15-4 or E6-12 (ST1-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E6
ECM
ST1Y
A56986
A67404
STP
NG
A87771
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
776
05-587
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0505
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05C1S-13
IDLE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The idle speed is controlled by the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS).
The ETCS is composed of the throttle motor, which operates the throttle valve, and the throttle position sensor, which detects the opening angle of the throttle valve.
The ECM controls the throttle motor to provide the proper throttle valve opening angle to obtain the target
idle speed.
The ECM regulates the idle speed by opening and closing the throttle valve using the ETCS. The ECM concludes that the idle speed control ECM function is malfunctioning if: 1) the actual idle RPM varies more than
the specified amount five times or more during a drive cycle, or 2) a learning value of the idle speed control
remains at the maximum or minimum five times or more during a drive cycle. The ECM will turn on the MIL
and set a DTC.
Example:
If the actual idle RPM varies from the target idle RPM by more than 200* rpm five times during a drive cycle,
the ECM will turn on the MIL and will set a DTC.
HINT:
*: RPM threshold varies with engine load.
Large
Idle Engine
RPM
Target RPM
Maximum
Learning Value
of the Idle Speed
Control
0
Actual Idle RPM
Minimum
Small
Time
Time
A82389
DTC No.
P0505
DTC Detection Condition
Idle speed continues to vary greatly from target speed
(1 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
ETCS
Air induction system
PCV hose connection
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
777
05-588
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0505: IAC Functional Check
P0505: IAC Range Check
Required sensors / components (Main)
ETCS (Electrical throttle control system)
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP sensor, ECT sensor and VSS
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 minutes
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-377
Engine
Running
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Frequency that both of the following conditions (a) and (b)
are met:
5 times or more
(a) Engine RPM - target engine RPM
Less than -100 rpm, or more than 150 rpm
(b) Vehicle condition
Stop after vehicle was driven at 10 km/h (6.25 mph) or more
2. Frequency that both of the following conditions (a) and (b)
are met:
Once
(a) Engine RPM - target engine RPM
Less than -100 rpm, or more than 150 rpm
(b) ISC flow rate learning value
1.3 L/sec or less, or 9.03 L/sec or more
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
778
05-589
DIAGNOSTICS
1
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0505)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
Only P0505 is output
A
P0505 and other DTCs are output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0505 are output, perform the troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-412 )
A
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF PCV HOSE
OK: PCV hose is connected correctly. And PCV hose has no damage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
3
(a)
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Check for vacuum leaks in air induction system.
OK: No leak in air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
OK
CHECK ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL SYSTEM (See page 10-12 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
779
05-590
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0560
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXG-05
SYSTEM VOLTAGE
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The battery supplies electricity to the ECM even when the ignition switch is OFF. This electricity allows the
ECM store data such as DTC history, freeze frame data, fuel trim values, and other data. If the battery voltage
falls below a minimum level, the ECM will conclude that there is a fault in the power supply circuit. The next
time the engine starts, the ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC will be set.
DTC No.
P0560
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Open in back-up power source circuit
ECM
Open in ECM back-up power source circuit
(1 trip detection logic)
HINT:
If DTC P0560 is present, the ECM will not store other DTCs.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0560: ECM System Voltage
Required sensors / components (Main)
ECM
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
3 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate (MIL will illuminate after the next engine start)
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
ECM power source
Less than 3.5 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
780
05-591
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Engine Room J/B
W
1
2I
EFI NO. 1
7
2B
11
IK2
B-W
BR
3
BATT
E5
3
F7
FL Block Assy
1
W
BR
Main
1
E7 E1
A
J7
J/C
Battery
A
BR
ED
A88697
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT FUSE (EFI NO. 1)
(a)
(b)
Engine Room J/B
EFI NO. 1 Fuse
A90343
Remove the EFI NO. 1 fuse from the engine room J/B.
Check the resistance of the EFI NO. 1 fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
781
05-592
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM (BATT VOLTAGE)
(a)
E1 (-)
BATT (+)
E9
ECM
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-3 (BATT) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
E5
ECM
A67446
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - EFI NO. 1 FUSE, EFI NO. 1 FUSE - BATTERY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
Engine Room J/B
Check the wire harness between the EFI NO. 1 fuse and
ECM.
(1) Remove the EFI NO. 1 fuse from the engine room
J/B.
(2) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
J/B EFI NO. 1 fuse terminal 2 - E5-3 (BATT)
Below 1 Ω
J/B EFI NO. 1 fuse terminal 2 or E5-3 (BATT) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
EFI NO. 1 Fuse
E5
ECM
BATT
A80025
A67445
A92384
Specified Condition
(b)
Check the wire harness between the EFI NO. 1 fuse and
battery.
(1) Remove the EFI NO. 1 fuse from the engine room
J/B.
(2) Disconnect the battery positive cable.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery positive cable - J/B EFI NO. 1 fuse terminal 1
Below 1 Ω
Battery positive cable or J/B EFI NO. 1 fuse terminal 1 Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
782
05-593
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
052O7-42
DTC
P0604
INTERNAL CONTROL MODULE RANDOM
ACCESS MEMORY (RAM) ERROR
DTC
P0606
ECM/PCM PROCESSOR
DTC
P0607
CONTROL MODULE PERFORMANCE
DTC
P0657
ACTUATOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE
CIRCUIT/OPEN
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM continuously monitors its internal memory status, internal circuits, and output signals to the throttle
actuator. This self-check ensures that the ECM is functioning properly. If any malfunction is detected, the
ECM will set the appropriate DTC and illuminate the MIL.
The ECM memory status is diagnosed by internal ”mirroring” of the main CPU and the sub CPU to detect
Random Access Memory (RAM) errors. The two CPUs also perform continuous mutual monitoring. The
ECM sets a DTC if: 1) outputs from the 2 CPUs are different and deviate from the standards, 2) the signals
to the throttle actuator deviate from the standards, 3) a malfunction is found in the throttle actuator supply
voltage, and 4) any other ECM malfunction is found.
DTC No.
P0604
P0606
P0607
P0657
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
ECM internal error
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0604: RAM Error
P0606: CPU Malfunction
P0607: ECM Range Check
P0657: ETCS Power Supply
Required sensors / components (Main)
ECM
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
Within 1 second
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
RAM Error P0604:
RAM
RAM check failure
CPU Malfunction P0606:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Difference between TP of main CPU and TP of sub CPU
0.3 V or more
2. Difference between APP of main CPU and APP of sub
CPU
0.3 V or more
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
783
05-594
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
ECM Range Check P0607:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. All of the following conditions are met:
Conditions (a), (b) and (c)
(a) CPU reset
1 time or more
(b) Difference between TP and APP learned
0.4 V or more
(c) Electronic throttle actuator
OFF
2. CPU reset
2 times or more
ETCS Power Supply P0657:
ETCS power supply when ignition switch turns from OFF to
ON
7 V or more
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
784
05-595
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0617
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05BNV-11
STARTER RELAY CIRCUIT HIGH
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
While the engine is being cranked, the battery positive voltage is applied to terminal STA of the ECM.
If the vehicle is being driven and the ECM detects the starter control signal (STA), the ECM concludes that
the starter control circuit is malfunctioning. The ECM will turn on the MIL and will set a DTC.
DTC No.
P0617
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met and the battery (+B)
voltage 10.5 V or more is applied for 20 seconds:
(1 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed greater than 20 km/h (12 mph)
(b) Engine revolution greater than 1,000 rpm
(c) STA signal ON
Short in PNP switch assy circuit
PNP switch assy
Ignition switch
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0617: Starter Signal
Required sensors / components (Main)
Starter Relay and PNP Switch
Required sensors / components (Related)
CKP Sensor and Vehicle Speed Sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
20 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Vehicle speed
20 km/h (12.4 mph) or more
Engine RPM
1,000 rpm or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Starter signal
ON
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
785
05-596
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
P1
PNP Switch
B
3
B-R
EB2
4
L
W
2
AM1
1
1 1A
B
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
2
6 1C
3
B-Y
IC1
B
AM1
7
AM2
ST1
1
ST2
B-W
8
17 STA
E7
B
N P
4 EB2
2
STARTER
L-W
2
1
2
B-W
IC1
B
5
Engine
Room R/B No. 2
I15
Ignition Switch
ECM
2
5
2
2
ST Relay
1
3
Y
2
2
2
W-B
W-R
1 IC1
1
E7 E1
BR
L-Y
10
ALT
AM2
2
4 EB1
F7
FL Block
Assy
B-W
1
A
A
J7
J/C
J2
J/C
W
FL
Main
A
1
B
1
S2
BR
S1
Battery
Starter
EH
ED
A88698
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
786
05-597
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Hand-held tester:
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (STA SIGNAL)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST
/ ALL / STARTER SIG. Read the values.
Result:
Ignition Switch Condition
ON
START
STA Signal
OFF
ON
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
2
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY (See page 05-1036 )
OK:
When shift lever is the N position, the PNP switch is ON.
When shift lever is the P position, the PNP switch is OFF.
NG
REPLACE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (See page 40-7 ) (Go to step 3 AFTER REPLACEMENT)
OK
3
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (STA SIGNAL)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST
/ ALL / STARTER SIG. Read the values.
Result:
Ignition Switch Condition
ON
START
STA Signal
OFF
ON
OK
SYSTEM OK
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
787
05-598
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSY
(a)
AM1
I15
Ignition
Switch
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
ST2
ST1
Check the resistance of the ignition switch terminals.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
LOCK
1-2
7-8
10 kΩ or higher
START
1-2
7-8
Below 1 Ω
NG
AM2
A56879
REPLACE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSY (Go to next step 5 AFTER REPLACEMENT)
OK
5
(a)
(b)
(c)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (STA SIGNAL)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held tester main switch ON.
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST
/ ALL / STARTER SIG. Read the values.
Result:
Ignition Switch Condition
ON
START
STA Signal
OFF
ON
OK
SYSTEM OK
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
OBD II scan tool (excluding Hand-held Tester):
1
INSPECT ECM
STA (+)
E7
ECM
(a)
(b)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
A76903
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
E7-17 (STA) - E9-1 (E1)
Ignition switch ON
0V
E7-17 (STA) - E9-1 (E1)
Engine cranking
6 V or more
OK
Specified Condition
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
788
05-599
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY (See page 05-1036 )
OK:
When shift lever is the N position, the PNP switch is ON.
When shift lever is the P position, the PNP switch is OFF.
NG
REPLACE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (See page 40-7 ) (Go to next step 3 AFTER
REPLACEMENT)
OK
3
INSPECT ECM
(a)
STA (+)
E1 (-)
E7
ECM
E9
ECM
A76903
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E7-17 (STA) - E9-1 (E1)
Ignition switch ON
0V
E7-17 (STA) - E9-1 (E1)
Engine cranking
6 V or more
OK
SYSTEM OK
NG
4
INSPECT IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSY
(a)
AM1
I15
Ignition
Switch
ST2
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
AM2
ST1
A56879
Check the resistance of the ignition switch terminals.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
LOCK
1-2
7-8
10 kΩ or higher
START
1-2
7-8
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH
ASSY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
789
05-600
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM
(a)
STA (+)
E7
ECM
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
A76903
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
E7-17 (STA) - E9-1 (E1)
Ignition switch ON
0V
E7-17 (STA) - E9-1 (E1)
Engine cranking
6 V or more
OK
Specified Condition
SYSTEM OK
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
790
05-601
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0630
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05MOS-01
VIN NOT PROGRAMMED OR MISMATCH ECM/PCM
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC P0630 is set when the Vehicle Indication Number (VIN) is not stored in the ECM or the input VIN is not
accurate. Input the VIN with the hand-held tester (see page 05-373 ).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
VIN is not stored in ECM
Input VIN in ECM is not accurate
P0630
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0630: VIN not programed
Required Sensors/Components (Main)
ECM
Required Sensors/Components (Related)
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Stater
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
VIN code
Not programmed
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VIN code
Programmed
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ CURRENT DTC
NOTICE:
If P0630 is present, the VIN must be input to the ECM using the hand-held tester. However, all DTCs
are cleared automatically by the tester when inputting the VIN. If DTCs other than P0630 are present,
check them first.
NEXT
2
INPUT VIN WITH HAND-HELD TESTER (See page 05-373 )
NEXT
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
791
05-602
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P0705
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
059VP-12
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR CIRCUIT
MALFUNCTION (PRNDL INPUT)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the shift lever is in the N or P position: 1) the Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch turns on, and 2) ECM
terminal NSW is grounded to the body ground via the starter relay and voltage becomes 0V. When the shift
lever is in the D, 2, L or R position: 1) the PNP switch turns off, and 2) ECM terminal NSW receives current
and becomes the voltage of the ECM internal power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air-fuel ratio correction
and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
DTC No.
P0705
DTC Detection Condition
2 or more switches are ON simultaneously at P R, N, D, 2 and
L positions (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Short in PNP switch circuit
PNP switch
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0705, use the hand-held tester to confirm the PNP switch signal in the ALL menu
(to reach the ALL menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0705 on page 05-1036 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to DTC P0705 on page 05-1036 .
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
792
05-603
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EXZ-05
DTC
P2102
THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL MOTOR
CIRCUIT LOW
DTC
P2103
THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL MOTOR
CIRCUIT HIGH
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor which is mounted on the
throttle body. The throttle position sensor provides feedback to the ECM. This feedback allows the ECM to
control the throttle motor and monitor the throttle opening angle in response to driver inputs.
HINT:
This Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) does not use a throttle cable.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2102
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2.0 seconds:
(a) Throttle control motor output duty 80 % or more
(b) Throttle control motor current 0.5 A or less
(1 trip detection logic)
Open in throttle control motor circuit
Throttle control motor
ECM
P2103
Either of following conditions is met:
Throttle control motor current 10 A or more (0.1 seconds)
Throttle control motor current 7 A or more (0.6 seconds)
(1 trip detection logic)
Short in throttle control motor circuit
Throttle control motor
Throttle valve
Throttle body Assy
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the flow of electrical current through the electronic throttle motor, and detects malfunctions or open circuits in the throttle motor based on the value of the electrical current. When the current deviates from the standard values, the ECM concludes that there is a fault in the throttle motor. Or, if the throttle
valve is not functioning properly (for example, stuck ON), the ECM concludes that there is a fault and turns
on the MIL and a DTC is set.
Example:
When the current is more than 10 A, or the current is less than 0.5A when the motor driving duty ratio is exceeding 80 %, the ECM concludes that the current is deviated from the standard values, turns on the MIL
and a DTC is set.
FAIL SAFE
If the ETCS, has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle control motor. The throttle control valve
returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16) by the force of the return spring. The ECM
then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in
accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
793
05-604
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2102: Throttle Actuator Current (Low current)
P2103: Throttle Actuator Current (High current)
Required sensors / components (Main)
Throttle actuator
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
P2102:
Throttle actuator duty ratio
80 % or more
Throttle actuator power supply
8 V or more
P2103:
Throttle actuator power supply
8 V or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2102:
Throttle actuator current
Less than 0.5 A
P2103:
Either of the following conditions is set:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Hybrid IC diagnosis signal (Throttle control motor current
is 10 A or more)
Fail (for 0.1 seconds)
2. Hybrid IC current limiter port (Throttle control motor current is 7 A or more)
Fail (for 0.6 seconds)
WIRING DIAGRAM
T13
Throttle Control Motor
ECM
Shielded
M+ 2
B
3
M+
E9
M-
W
2
ME9
1
17
E9 GE01
A87825
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
794
05-605
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY ASSY (RESISTANCE OF THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR)
(a)
(b)
T13
Throttle Control Motor
M+
Disconnect the T13 throttle control motor connector.
Check the resistance of the throttle control motor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T13-2 (M+) - T13-1 (M-)
0.3 to 100 Ω 20C (68F)
MA59778
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSY
(See page 10-18 )
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
T13
Throttle Control Motor
M-
Disconnect the T13 throttle control motor connector.
Disconnect the E9 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
M+
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T13-2 (M+) - E9-3 (M+)
T13-1 (M-) - E9-2 (M-)
Below 1 Ω
T13-2 (M+) or E9-3 (M+) - Body ground
T13-1 (M-) or E9-2 (M-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E9
ECM
M+
MY
B53781
A81698
A85540
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
795
05-606
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY ASSY
Visually check between the throttle valve and the housing for foreign objects.
Also, check if the valve can open and close smoothly.
OK: The throttle valve is not contaminated by foreign objects and can move smoothly.
NG
REMOVE FOREIGN OBJECT AND CLEAN
THROTTLE BODY
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
796
05-607
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EY0-05
DTC
P2111
THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL SYSTEM
- STUCK OPEN
DTC
P2112
THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL SYSTEM
- STUCK CLOSED
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve using gears. The opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor, which is mounted on the throttle body.
The throttle position sensor provides feedback to the ECM to control the throttle motor and set the throttle
valve angle in response to driver inputs.
HINT:
This Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) does not use a throttle cable.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2111
Throttle valve locked during ECM order to close
(1 trip detection logic)
P2112
Throttle valve locked during ECM order to open
(1 trip detection logic)
Throttle control motor circuit
Throttle control motor
Throttle body
Throttle valve
Throttle control motor circuit
Throttle control motor
Throttle body
Throttle valve
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM concludes that there is a malfunction of the ETCS when the throttle valve remains at a fixed angle
despite high drive current from the ECM. The ECM will turn on the MIL and will set a DTC.
FAIL SAFE
If the ETCS has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle control motor. The throttle control valve
returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16) by the force of the return spring. The ECM
then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in
accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2111: Throttle actuator stuck open
P2112: Throttle actuator stuck closed
Required sensors / components (Main)
Throttle actuator
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
797
05-608
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
P2111:
Throttle motor current
2 A or more
Throttle motor close duty ratio
80% or more
P2112:
Throttle actuator current
2 A or more
Throttle actuator open duty ratio
80 % or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TP (Throttle position) sensor voltage change for 0.016 seconds
Less than 0.1 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2102 on page 05-603 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK THROTTLE BODY ASSY
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P2111 or P2112
A
P2111 or P2112 and other DTCs
B
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSY
(See page 10-18 )
OK
2
CHECK THROTTLE BODY ASSY (VISUALLY CHECK THROTTLE VALVE)
Check for contamination between the throttle valve and the housing. If necessary, clean the throttle body.
And check that the throttle valve moves smoothly.
OK: The throttle valve is not contaminated by foreign objects and can move smoothly.
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSY
(See page 10-18 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
798
05-609
DIAGNOSTICS
3
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK DTC OUTPUT
Clear the DTC.
Start the engine, and depress and release the accelerator pedal quickly (fully open and fully close).
Read DTC.
Result:
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
No DTC
A
P2111 and/or P2112
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEM (See page 05-370 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
799
05-610
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P2118
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
052NY-20
THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL MOTOR
CURRENT RANGE/PERFORMANCE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has a dedicated power supply circuit. The voltage (+BM) is
monitored and when the voltage is low (less than 4V), the ECM concludes that the ETCS has a fault and
current to the throttle control motor is cut.
When the voltage becomes unstable, the ETCS condition itself becomes unstable. For this reason, when
the voltage is low, the current to the motor is cut. If repairs are made and the system has returned to normal,
turn the ignition switch OFF. The ECM then allows current to flow to the motor and the motor can be restarted.
HINT:
This ETCS does not use a throttle cable.
ECM
ETCS
+BM
From Battery
Throttle Control Motor
M+
M-
Motor Control
Circuit
ME01
A87799
DTC No.
P2118
DTC Detection Condition
Open in ETCS power source circuit (1 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Open in ETCS power source circuit
ETCS fuse
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
800
05-61 1
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the battery supply voltage applied to the electronic throttle motor. When the power supply
voltage drops below the threshold, the ECM concludes that the power supply circuit has an open circuit. A
DTC is set and the MIL is turned on.
FAIL SAFE
If the ETCS has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle control motor. The throttle control valve
returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16) by the force of the return spring. The ECM
then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in
accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2118: Throttle Actuator Power Supply
Required sensors / components (Main)
Throttle actuator, ETCS fuse
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.8 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-377
Battery voltage
More than 8 V
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Throttle actuator power supply voltage
Less than 4 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Throttle actuator power supply voltage
9 to 14 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
801
05-612
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
4
IC1
R
T13
Throttle Control Motor
2
ETCS
M+
2
1
6
+BM
E6
W
2
Shielded
3
M+
E9
B
Engine Room
R/B No. 2
M-
1
Motor
Control
Circuit
2
ME9
W
2
17
E9 GE01
W
3
F7
FL Block Assy
4
ME01
E9
1
W
Main
W-B
Battery
EC
A88699
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
802
05-613
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK FUSE (ETCS)
(a)
(b)
Engine Room
R/B No. 2
Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room R/B No. 2.
Check the resistance of the ETCS fuse.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
ETCS Fuse
A80017
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
INSPECT ECM (+BM VOLTAGE)
(a)
E1 (-)
E9
ECM
+BM (+)
Check the voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E6-6 (+BM) - E9-1 (E1)
9 to 14 V
E6
ECM
A67446
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
803
05-614
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - ETCS FUSE, ETCS FUSE - BATTERY)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
Engine Room
R/B No. 2
ETCS Fuse
E6
ECM
A92543
Check the wire harness between the ETCS fuse and
ECM.
(1) Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room R/B
No. 2.
(2) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R/B No. 2 ETCS fuse terminal 2 - E6-6 (+BM)
Below 1 Ω
R/B No. 2 ETCS fuse terminal 2 or E6-6 (+BM) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(b)
+BM
A87846
A67404
-
Check the wire harness between the ETCS fuse and battery.
(1) Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room R/B
No. 2.
(2) Disconnect the battery positive cable.
(3) Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery positive cable - R/B No. 2 ETCS fuse terminal 1
Below 1 Ω
Battery positive cable or R/B No. 2 ETCS fuse terminal 1 Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
CHECK ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK NO.2
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
804
05-615
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P2119
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
059VR-18
THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL
THROTTLE BODY RANGE/PERFORMANCE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) is composed of a throttle motor that operates the throttle
valve, a throttle position sensor that detects the opening angle of the throttle valve, an accelerator pedal
position sensor that detects the accelerator pedal position, and the ECM that controls the ETCS system.
The ECM operates the throttle motor to position the throttle valve for proper response to driver inputs. The
throttle position sensor, which is mounted on the throttle body, detects the opening angle of the throttle valve
and provides this signal to the ECM so that the ECM can regulate the throttle motor.
DTC No.
P2119
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Throttle opening angle continues to vary greatly from target
throttle opening angle (1 trip detection logic)
ETCS
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM determines the ”actual” throttle angle based on the throttle position sensor signal. The ”actual”
throttle position is compared to the ”target” throttle position commanded by the ECM. If the difference between these two values exceeds a specified limit, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the ETCS system. The
ECM turns on the MIL and a DTC is set.
FAIL SAFE
If the ETCS has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle control motor. The throttle control valve
returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16) by the force of the return spring. The ECM
then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection (intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in
accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable the vehicle to continue at a minimal speed.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2119: ETCS malfunction
Required sensors / components (Main)
Throttle actuator
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
1 second
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference between ”target closed TP (Throttle position) ”
and ”actual closed TP”
Difference between ”target open TP” and ”actual open TP”
0.3 V or more for 1 seconds
0.3 V or more for 0.6 seconds
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2102 on page 05-603 .
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
805
05-616
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2119)
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
Only P2119 is output
A
P2119 and other codes are output
B
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-412 )
A
2
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUT REOCCUR
(a) Clear the DTC (see page 05-400 ).
(b) Allow the engine to idle for 15 seconds.
(c) Pull the hand brake and shift the gear to D.
(d) Depress the brake pedal securely and the accelerator pedal fully for 5 seconds.
(e) Read the DTC.
HINT:
Actual throttle position (TP) sensor voltage can be confirmed using the hand-held tester [DATA LIST/ALL/
THROTTLE POS #1].
OK: No DTC output.
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY ASSY
(See page 10-18 )
OK
NORMAL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
806
05-617
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05IR0-02
DTC
P2120
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”D” CIRCUIT
DTC
P2122
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”D” CIRCUIT LOW INPUT
DTC
P2123
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”D” CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
DTC
P2125
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”E” CIRCUIT
DTC
P2127
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”E” CIRCUIT LOW INPUT
DTC
P2128
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”E” CIRCUIT HIGH INPUT
DTC
P2138
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”D”/”E” VOLTAGE
CORRELATION
HINT:
This is the repair procedure for the ”accelerator pedal position sensor”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
807
05-618
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
HINT:
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
Magnet
IC No. 1
ECM
VPA
EPA
VCPA
VPA2
EPA2
IC No. 2
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor Output Voltage (V)
This electrical throttle system does not use a throttle cable.
This accelerator pedal position sensor is a non-contact type.
The accelerator pedal position sensor is mounted on the accelerator pedal bracket to detect the angle of
the accelerator pedal. This sensor is electronically controlled and uses Hall-effect elements.
In the accelerator pedal position sensor, the voltage applied to terminals VPA and VPA2 of the ECM changes
between 0 V and 5 V in proportion to the angle of the accelerator pedal. The VPA is a signal to indicate the
actual accelerator pedal angle which is used for the engine control. VPA2 is used to detect malfunctions of
the sensor itself.
The ECM judges the accelerator pedal angle from VPA and VPA2 signal outputs, and the ECM controls the
throttle motor based on these signals.
*1
*2
5
3.4 to 5.3
2.6 to 4.5
1.6
0.8
0
VCP2
Usable Range
25
Accelerator Pedal Turning Angle (deg.)
Magnet
*1: Accelerator Pedal Released
*2:
Accelerator Pedal Fully Depressed
A19694
A19803
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
808
05-619
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
DTC Detection Condition
(All of the following are 1trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
P2120
Condition (a) continues for 0.5 seconds or more:
(a) VPA is 0.2 V or less or VPA is 4.8 V or more
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
P2122
VPA is 0.2 V or less for 0.5 seconds or more when VPA2 output indicates accelerator pedal is opened
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in VCP1 circuit
VPA circuit open or ground short
ECM
P2123
Condition (a) continues for 2.0 seconds or more:
(a) VPA is 4.8 V or more
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in EPA circuit
ECM
P2125
Condition (a) continues for 0.5 seconds or more:
(a) (VPA2 is 0.5 V or less or (VPA2 is 4.8 V or more
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
P2127
VPA2 is 0.5 V or less for 0.5 seconds or more when VPA output indicates accelerator pedal is opened
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in VCP2 circuit
VPA2 circuit open or ground short
ECM
P2128
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2.0 seconds or more:
(a) VPA2 is 4.8 V or more
(b) VPA is 0.2 V or more and VPA is 3.45 V or less
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Open in EPA2 circuit
ECM
P2138
Condition (a) or (b) continues for 2.0 seconds or more:
(a) Difference between VPA and VPA2 is 0.02 V or less
(b) VPA is 0.2 V or less and VPA2 is 0.5 V or less
VPA and VPA2 circuit are short circuit
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P2120, P2122, P2123, P2125, P2127, P2128 and P2138, use the hand-held tester
or the OBD II scan tool to confirm the accelerator pedal position sensor output voltage.
Accelerator pedal
position expressed as
voltage output
Accelerator pedal
position expressed as
voltage output
Accelerator pedal
position expressed as
voltage output
Accelerator pedal
position expressed as
voltage output
Accelerator pedal released
Accelerator pedal released
Accelerator pedal depressed
Accelerator pedal depressed
Trouble Area
ACCEL POS #1
ACCEL POS #2
ACCEL POS #1
ACCEL POS #2
VCP circuit open
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
VPA circuit open or ground short
0 to 0.2 V
1.2 to 2.0 V
0 to 0.2 V
3.4 to 5.3 V
VPA2 circuit open or ground short
0.5 to 1.1 V
0 to 0.2 V
2.6 to 4.5 V
0 to 0.2 V
EPA circuit open
4.5 to 5.5 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
4.5 to 5.5 V
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
When VPA or VPA2 deviates from the standard, or the difference between the voltage outputs of the two
sensors is less than the threshold, the ECM concludes that there is a defect in the accelerator pedal position
sensor. The ECM turns on the MIL and a DTC is set.
Example:
The voltage output of the VPA is below 0.2 V or exceeds 4.8 V.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
809
05-620
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
FAIL SAFE
The accelerator pedal position sensor has 2 (main and sub) sensor circuits. If a malfunction occurs in either
of the sensor circuits, the ECM detects the abnormal signal voltage difference between the two sensor circuits and switches to fail-safe mode. In fail-safe mode, the functioning circuit is used to calculate the accelerator pedal opening angle to allow the vehicle to continue driving. If both circuits malfunction, the ECM regards the opening angle of the accelerator pedal to be fully closed. In this case, the throttle valve will remain
closed as if the engine is idling.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2120: APP Sensor 1 Range Check (Chattering)
P2122: APP Sensor 1 Range Check (Low voltage)
P2123: APP Sensor 1 Range Check (High voltage)
P2125: APP Sensor 2 Range Check (Chattering)
P2127: APP Sensor 2 Range Check (Low voltage)
P2128: APP Sensor 2 Range Check (High voltage)
P2138: APP Sensor Range Check (Correlation)
Required sensors / components (Main)
APP sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2120:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. VPA1 voltage when VPA2 is 0.97 or more
0.2 V or less
2. VPA1 voltage
4.8 V or more
P2122:
VPA1 voltage when VPA2 is 0.97 or more
0.2 V or less
P2123:
VPA1 voltage
4.8 V or more
P2125:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. VPA2 voltage when VPA1 is 0.97 or more
0.5 V or less
2. VPA2 voltage when VPA1 is 0.2 to 3.45 V
4.8 V or more
P2127:
VPA2 voltage when VPA1 is 0.97 or more
0.5 V or less
P2128:
VPA2 voltage when VPA1 is 0.2 to 3.45 V
4.8 V or more
P2138:
Either of the following conditions is met:
Condition 1 or 2
1. Difference betrween VPA 1 and VPA2 voltage
0.02 V or less
Condition 2
-
VPA1 voltage
0.2 V or less
VPA2 voltage
0.5 V or less
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
810
05-621
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
VPA1 voltage
0.5 to 4.5 V
VPA2 voltage
1.2 to 4.8 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
A27
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
VCP2
VPA2
EPA2
VCPA
VPA
EPA
ECM
L
27
VCP2
E5
W
23
VPA2
E5
BR
29
EPA2
E5
G
26
VCPA
E5
B
22
VPA
E5
R
28
EPA
E5
1
3
2
4
6
5
Y
A92550
A92550
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame date can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occured.
Hand-held tester:
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (ACCEL POS #1 AND ACCEL POS #2)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Depressed
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ETCS
/ ACCEL POS #1 and ACCEL POS #2. Read the values.
Standard:
Accelerator Pedal
ACCEL POS #1
ACCEL POS #2
Released
0.5 to 1.1 V
1.2 to 2.0 V
Depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
3.4 to 5.3 V
Released
FI7052
OK
Go to step 5
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
811
05-622
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
A27
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
VCP2
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the A27 accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A27-6 (VCP1) - E5-26 (VCPA)
A27-5 (VPA1) - E5-22 (VPA)
A27-4 (VCP2) - E5-27 (VCP2)
A27-3 (EP1) - E5-28 (EPA)
A27-2 (VPA2) - E5-23 (VPA2)
A27-1 (EP2) - E5-29 (EPA2)
Below 1 Ω
A27-6 (VCP1) or E5-26 (VCPA) - Body ground
A27-5 (VPA1) or E5-22 (VPA) - Body ground
A27-4 (VCP2) or E5-27 (VCP2) - Body ground
A27-3 (EP1) or E5-28 (EPA) - Body ground
A27-2 (VPA2) or E5-23 (VPA2) - Body ground
A27-1 (EP2) or E5-29 (EPA2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VPA
EPA2 VPA2
VCPA
VPA
EPA
VCP2
VCPA
E5
ECM
VPA2
EPA2
EPA
B83781
A67445
A92545
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
3
INSPECT ECM (VCPA AND VCP2 VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
A27
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
VCP2 (+)
A19521
A53765
Disconnect the A27 accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Cheak the voltage of the E5 ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-26 (VCPA) - E5-28 (EPA)
E5-27 (VCP2) - E5-29 (EPA2)
4.5 to 5.5 V
VCPA (+) E5
ECM
EPA2 (-) EPA (-)
A92544
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
812
05-623
DIAGNOSTICS
4
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY (See page 10-26 )
GO
5
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
READ OUTPUT DTC (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR DTCS ARE
OUTPUT AGAIN
Clear the DTC (see page 05-400 ).
Start the engine.
Run the engine at idle for 15 seconds or more.
Read the DTC (see page 05-400 ).
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2120, P2122, P2123, P2125, P2127, P2128 and/or P2138 are output again
A
No DTC output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
A
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
A27
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
VCP2
EPA2 VPA2
A27-6 (VCP1) - E5-26 (VCPA)
A27-5 (VPA1) - E5-22 (VPA)
A27-4 (VCP2) - E5-27 (VCP2)
A27-3 (EP1) - E5-28 (EPA)
A27-2 (VPA2) - E5-23 (VPA2)
A27-1 (EP2) - E5-29 (EPA2)
Below 1 Ω
A27-6 (VCP1) or E5-26 (VCPA) - Body ground
A27-5 (VPA1) or E5-22 (VPA) - Body ground
A27-4 (VCP2) or E5-27 (VCP2) - Body ground
A27-3 (EP1) or E5-28 (EPA) - Body ground
A27-2 (VPA2) or E5-23 (VPA2) - Body ground
A27-1 (EP2) or E5-29 (EPA2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VPA
VCPA EPA
VPA
B83781
A67445
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the A27 accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
VCP2
VCPA
E5
ECM
VPA2
EPA2
EPA
A92545
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
813
05-624
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT ECM (VCPA AND VCP2 VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
A27
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
VCP2 (+)
Disconnect the A27 accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Cheak the voltage of the E5 ECM connector.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-26 (VCPA) - E5-28 (EPA)
E5-27 (VCP2) - E5-29 (EPA2)
4.5 to 5.5 V
VCPA (+) E5
ECM
EPA2 (-) EPA (-)
A19521
A53765
A92544
NG
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
OK
3
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY (See page 10-26 )
GO
4
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
READ OUTPUT DTC (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR DTCS ARE
OUTPUT AGAIN)
Clear the DTC (see page 05-400 ).
Start the engine.
Run the engine at idle for 15 seconds or more.
Read the DTC (see page 05-400 ).
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2120, P2122, P2123, P2125, P2127, P2128 and/or P2138 are output again
A
No DTC output
B
B
SYSTEM OK
A
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
814
05-625
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
P2121
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05IQM-02
THROTTLE/PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR/SWITCH ”D” CIRCUIT
RANGE/PERFORMANCE
HINT:
This is repair procedure for the ”accelerator pedal position sensor”.
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2120 on page 05-617 .
DTC No.
P2121
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Conditions (a) continue for 0.5 seconds:
(a) Difference between VPA and VPA2 exceeds the threshold
(1 trip detection logic)
Open or short in accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The accelerator pedal position sensor is mounted on the accelerator pedal bracket. The accelerator pedal
position sensor has 2 sensors elements/signal output: VPA and VPA2.
VPA is used to detect the actual accelerator pedal angle (used for engine control) and VPA2 is used to detect
malfunctions in VPA. When the difference between the voltage outputs of VPA and VPA2 deviates from the
standard, the ECM concludes the accelerator pedal position sensor has a malfunction. ECM turns on the
MIL and a DTC is set.
FAIL SAFE
The accelerator pedal position sensor has 2 (main and sub) sensor circuits. If a malfunction occurs in either
of the sensor circuits, the ECM detects the abnormal signal voltage difference between the 2 sensor circuits
and switches to fail-sefe mode. In fail-sefe mode, the functioning circuit is used to calculate the accelerator
pedal opening angle to allow the vehicle to continue driving. If both circuits malfunction, the ECM regards
the opening angle of the accelerator pedal to be fully closed. In this case, the throttle valve will remain closed
as if the engine is idling.
If a ”pass” condition is detected and then the ignition switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2121: TP sensor malfunction
Required sensors / components (Main)
Accelerator position sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-377
Ignition switch
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
VPA1 - VPA2 (learning voltage)
Below 0.4 V, or more than 1.2 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
815
05-626
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2120 on page 05-617 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records the
engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame date can help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean
or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction.
Hand-held tester:
1
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER (ACCEL POS #1, ACCEL POS #2)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Depressed
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ETCS
/ ACCEL POS #1 and ACCEL POS #2. Read the values.
Standard:
Accelerator Pedal
ACCEL POS #1
ACCEL POS #2
Released
0.5 to 1.1 V
1.2 to 2.0 V
Depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
3.4 to 5.3 V
Released
FI7052
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
816
05-627
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
A27
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
VCP2
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the A27 accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A27-6 (VCP1) - E5-26 (VCPA)
A27-5 (VPA1) - E5-22 (VPA)
A27-4 (VCP2) - E5-27 (VCP2)
A27-3 (EP1) - E5-28 (EPA)
A27-2 (VPA2) - E5-23 (VPA2)
A27-1 (EP2) - E5-29 (EPA2)
Below 1 Ω
A27-6 (VCP1) or E5-26 (VCPA) - Body ground
A27-5 (VPA1) or E5-22 (VPA) - Body ground
A27-4 (VCP2) or E5-27 (VCP2) - Body ground
A27-3 (EP1) or E5-28 (EPA) - Body ground
A27-2 (VPA2) or E5-23 (VPA2) - Body ground
A27-1 (EP2) or E5-29 (EPA2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VPA
EPA2 VPA2
VCPA EPA
VPA
VCP2
VCPA
E5
ECM
VPA2
EPA2
EPA
B83781
A67445
A92545
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY (See page 10-26 )
OBD II scan tool (excluding hand-held tester):
1
INSPECT ECM (VPA, VPA2 VOLTAGE)
VPA2 (+)
VPA (+)
(a)
(b)
E5
ECM
EPA2 (-) EPA (-)
A53765
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Check the voltage of the ECM connector.
Tester Condition
Accelerator Pedal
Condition
Specified Condition
E5-22 (VPA) - E5-28
(EPA)
Released
0.5 to 1.1 V
E5-22 (VPA) - E5-28
(EPA)
Depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
E5-23 (VPA2) - E5-29
(EPA2)
Released
1.2 to 2.9 V
E5-23 (VPA2) - E5-29
(EPA2)
Depressed
3.4 to 5.5 V
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
817
05-628
DIAGNOSTICS
2
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
Wire Harness Side
A27
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
VCP2
EPA2 VPA2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A27-6 (VCP1) - E5-26 (VCPA)
A27-5 (VPA1) - E5-22 (VPA)
A27-4 (VCP2) - E5-27 (VCP2)
A27-3 (EP1) - E5-28 (EPA)
A27-2 (VPA2) - E5-23 (VPA2)
A27-1 (EP2) - E5-29 (EPA2)
Below 1 Ω
A27-6 (VCP1) or E5-26 (VCPA) - Body ground
A27-5 (VPA1) or E5-22 (VPA) - Body ground
A27-4 (VCP2) or E5-27 (VCP2) - Body ground
A27-3 (EP1) or E5-28 (EPA) - Body ground
A27-2 (VPA2) or E5-23 (VPA2) - Body ground
A27-1 (EP2) or E5-29 (EPA2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
VPA
VCPA EPA
VPA
B83781
A67445
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the A27 accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
VCP2
VCPA
E5
ECM
VPA2
EPA2
EPA
A92545
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY (See page 10-26 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
818
05-629
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EY1-06
DTC
P2195
OXYGEN (A/F) SENSOR SIGNAL STUCK
LEAN (BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2196
OXYGEN (A/F) SENSOR SIGNAL STUCK
RICH (BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2197
OXYGEN (A/F) SENSOR SIGNAL STUCK
LEAN (BANK 2 SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2198
OXYGEN (A/F) SENSOR SIGNAL STUCK
RICH (BANK 2 SENSOR 1)
HINT:
Although the title (DTC description) says ”oxygen sensor”, this DTC is related to the ”A/F sensor”.
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Air Fuel ratio sensor provides output voltage* approximately equal to the existing air-fuel ratio. The A/F
sensor output voltage is used to provide feedback for the ECM to control the air-fuel ratio.
With the A/F sensor output, the ECM can determine deviation from the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio and control proper injection time. If the A/F sensor is malfunctioning, the ECM is unable to accurately control air-fuel
ratio.
The A/F sensor is equipped with a heater which heats the zirconia element. The heater is also controlled
by the ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temperature of the exhaust gas is low), current flows
to the heater to heat the sensor to facilitate detection of accurate oxygen concentration.
The A/F sensor is a planar type. Compared to a conventional type, the sensor and heater portions are narrower. Because the heat of the heater is conducted through the alumina to zirconia (of the sensor portion),
sensor activation is accelerated.
To obtain a high purification rate of the CO, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a three-way catalytic converter is used. The converter is most efficient when the air-fuel ratio is maintained near the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio.
HINT:
*: The voltage value changes on the inside of the ECM only.
ECM Monitored
A/F Sensor Voltage
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Alumina
Heater
Platinum
Electrode
Element
Exhaust Gas
A
Cover
Atmosphere
A
Air-fuel Ratio
A-A Section
A73819
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
819
05-630
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
P2195
P2197
P2196
P2198
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2 sec. or more:
(a) A/F sensor voltage is more than 3.8 V
(b) Heated oxygen sensor voltage is 0.15 V or more
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
PCV hose connection
ECM
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2 sec. or more:
(a) A/F sensor voltage is less than 2.8 V
(b) Heated oxygen sensor voltage is less than 0.85 V
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuit
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
PCV hose connection
ECM
HINT:
DTCs P2195 and P2196 indicate a malfunction related to bank 1 of the A/F sensor circuit.
DTCs P2197 and P2198 indicate a malfunction related to bank 2 of the A/F sensor circuit.
Bank 1 is the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
Bank 2 is the bank that includes cylinder No. 2.
Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
After confirming DTC P2195, P2196, P2197 or P2198, use the hand−held tester or the OBD II scan tool
to confirm A/F sensor output voltage (AFS B1S1 / AFS B2S1) from the ALL menu (to reach the ALL
menu: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / ALL).
The A/F sensor’s output voltage and the short−term fuel trim value can be read using the OBD II scan
tool or the hand−held tester.
The ECM controls the voltage of the A1A+, A2A+, A1A− and A2A− terminals of the ECM to a fixed
voltage. Therefore, it is impossible to confirm the A/F sensor output voltage without the OBD II scan
tool or the hand-held tester.
The OBD II scan tool (excluding hand−held tester) displays one fifth of the A/F sensor output voltage
which is displayed on the hand−held tester.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Under the air-fuel ratio feedback control, if the voltage output of the A/F sensor indicates RICH or LEAN for
more than a certain period of time, the ECM concludes that there is a fault in the A/F sensor system. The
ECM will turn on the MIL and will set a DTC.
Example:
If the A/F sensor voltage output is less than 2.8 V (very RICH) for 10 seconds even though voltage output
of the heated oxygen sensor output voltage is less than 0.85 V, the ECM sets DTC P2196 or DTC P2198.
If the heated oxygen sensor output voltage is 0.15 V or more but the A/F sensor voltage output is more than
3.8 V (very LEAN) 10 seconds, DTC P2195 or DTC P2197 is set.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
820
05-631
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2195: A/F Sensor Signal (Bank 1) Stuck Lean
P2196: A/F Sensor Signal (Bank 1) Stuck Rich
P2197: A/F Sensor Signal (Bank 2) Stuck Lean
P2198: A/F Sensor Signal (Bank 2) Stuck Rich
Required sensors / components (Main)
A/F sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
Rear HO2S
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
Time after engine start
30 seconds or more
A/F sensor status
Activated
Fuel system status
Closed Loop
Engine condition
Running
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2195 and P2197:
Both of the following conditions are met:
-
A/F sensor voltage
More than 3.8 V
Rear HO2S voltage
0.15 V or more
P2196 and P2198:
Both of the following conditions are met:
-
A/F sensor voltage
Less than 2.8 V
Rear HO2S voltage
Less than 0.85 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
821
05-632
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
A6
A/F Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
3
B-R
EB1
2 +B
ECM
5 HA1H
E8
B-W
HT 1
Shielded
BR
4
G
R-W
Engine Room R/B No. 2
2
2
A/F
AF+
3
30
E8 A1A-
Y
2
A7 A/F Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
A/F Relay
1
AF-
5
3
1
2
2
R-W
R-W
6
B-R
EB1
2 +B
4 HA2A
E8
R-W
HT 1
Shielded
P
4 AF-
2
AF+ 3
2
2
P-L
5 2G
22 A1A+
E8
23 A2A+
E8
31
E8 A2A-
L
W-B
7 2A
Engine
Room J/B
W
5 2B
4 2F
P-L
13
IK3
8
E5
B
MREL
3
F7
FL Block Assy
W-B
1
W
A
J2
J/C
FL
Main
A
A
BR
J7
J/C
A
1
E7 E1
A
BR
Battery
EH
ED
A88700
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
822
05-633
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
(d)
60 to 120 km/h
(38 to 75 mph)
Idling
Ignition Switch OFF
(c)
2 min.
3 to 5 min.
(a), (b)
Time
A79199
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Switch the hand-held tester from the normal mode to the check mode (see page 05-402 ).
Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessory switches OFF.
Drive the vehicle at 60 to 120 km/h (38 to 75 mph) and engine speed at 1,400 to 3,200 rpm for 3 to
5 minutes.
HINT:
If a malfunction exists, the MIL will be illuminated during step (d).
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of a malfunction will not occur. If you
do not have a hand-held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after performing steps (c) and (d), then
perform steps (c) and (d) again.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
It is possible the malfunctioning area can be found using the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation. The
A/F CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential trouble
areas are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume 12.5 % or increases the injection volume 25%.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(5) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine idle (press the right or left button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: Less than 0.4 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
823
05-634
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Output voltage of A/F sensor
(sensor 1)
Output voltage of heated oxygen
sensor (sensor 2)
Injection volume
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 1 Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
OK
More than 0.55 V
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 2 Output voltage
A/F sensor
(A/F sensor, heater, A/F sensor circuit)
Output voltage
NG
Injection volume
More than 0.55 V
OK
Less than 0.4V
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 3 Output voltage
Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
OK
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
NG
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 4 Output voltage
Almost
No reaction
OK
Less than 0.4V
+25 %
Less than 3.0V
Output voltage
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Mainly suspected
Trouble Area
Output voltage
NG
Almost
No reaction
NG
Heated oxygen sensor
(heated oxygen sensor,
heater, heated oxygen sensor
circuit)
Extremely rich or lean actual
air-fuel ratio
(Injector, fuel pressure, gas
leakage in exhaust system,
etc.)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables the technician to check and graph the voltage outputs of
both the A/F sensor and the heated oxygen sensor.
For displaying the graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2” by pressing ”YES” and push ”ENTER”. Then press ”F4”.
HINT:
If DTC P2195 or P2196 is displayed, check bank 1 sensor 1 circuit.
If DTC P2197 or P2198 is displayed, check bank 2 sensor 1 circuit.
A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a RICH air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run with a RICH air-fuel mixture.
A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a LEAN air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run with a LEAN air-fuel mixture.
Read freeze frame data using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
824
05-635
DIAGNOSTICS
1
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO A/F SENSOR DTC)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
A/F sensor circuit DTC are output
A
A/F sensor circuit DTC and other codes are output
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides A/F sensor DTC are output, perform the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-412 )
A
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF A/F SENSOR)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Warm up the A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately
90 seconds.
Read A/F sensor voltage output on the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Hand-held tester only:
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SNAPSHOT
/ MANUAL SNAPSHOT / USER DATA. Read the values.
Select ”AFS B1 S1 or AFS B2 S1 / ENGINE SPD” and press YES.
Monitor the A/F sensor voltage carefully.
Check the A/F sensor voltage output under the following conditions:
(1) Allow the engine to idle for 30 seconds.
(2) Run the engine at approximately 2,500 rpm. Do not suddenly change the rpm.
(3) Raise the engine to 4,000 rpm and quickly release the accelerator pedal so that the throttle is
fully closed.
Standard:
Condition (1) and (2)
Voltage change of 3.3 V (0.66 V)* (between approximately 3.1 to 3.5 V) as shown in the illustration.
Condition (3)
A/F sensor voltage increases to 3.8 V (0.76 V)* or more during engine deceleration when fuel
is cut as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
*: Voltage when using the OBD II scan tool.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
825
05-636
DIAGNOSTICS
Normal Condition
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Malfunction Condition
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(1) Idle
A/F
Sensor
Voltage
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
Engine
RPM
Engine
RPM
”Condition (3)”
3.8 V or More
A/F
Sensor
Voltage
Fuel Cut
Fuel Cut
”Condition (1), (2)”
Change of approximately 3.3 V
When A/F sensor circuit is malfunctioning,
voltage output does not change
A72304
HINT:
Whenever the A/F sensor output voltage remains at approximately 3.3 V (0.660 V)* (see ”Malfunction
Condition” graphic) under any condition as well as the above conditions, the A/F sensor may have an
open circuit. This will happen also when the A/F sensor heater has an open circuit.
Whenever the A/F sensor output voltage remains at a certain value of approximately 3.8 V (0.76 V)*
or more, or 2.8 V (0.56 V)* or less (see ”Malfunction Condition” graphic) under any condition as well
as the above conditions, the A/F sensor may have a short circuit.
The ECM will stop fuel injection (fuel is cut) during engine deceleration. This will cause a LEAN condition and should result in a momentary increase in A/F sensor output voltage.
The ECM must establish a closed throttle position learned value to perform fuel cut. If the battery terminal has been disconnected, the vehicle must be driven over 10 mph to allow the ECM to learn the
closed throttle position.
When the vehicle is driven:
The output voltage of the A/F sensor may be below 2.8 V (0.76 V)* during fuel enrichment. For the
vehicle, this translates to a sudden increase in speed with the accelerator pedal fully depressed when
trying to overtake another vehicle. The A/F sensor is functioning normally.
The A/F sensor is a current output element, and therefore the current is converted into voltage inside
the ECM. If measuring voltage at connectors of A/F sensor or ECM, you will observe a constant voltage.
*: Voltage when using the OBD II scan tool.
OK
Go to step 13
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
826
05-637
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATR RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
AF-
Disconnect the A6 or A7 A/F sensor connector.
Check the resistance of the A/F sensor terminals.
Resistance:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
20C (68F)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
-
10 kΩ or higher
AF+
A52607
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
4
INSPECT RELAY (A/F)
1
3
(a)
(b)
2
5
5
2
Remove the A/F relay from the engine room R/B No. 2.
Check the resistance of the A/F relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
1
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
827
05-638
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
HT
+B
Disconnect the A6 or A7 A/F sensor connector.
Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
A6 (Bank 1)
A7 (Bank 2)
A/F Sensor
AF+
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A6-3 (AF+) - E8-22 (A1A+)
A6-4 (AF-) - E8-30 (A1A-)
A6-1 (HT) - E8-5 (HA1H)
A7-3 (AF+) - E8-23 (A2A+)
A7-4 (AF-) - E8-31 (A2A-)
A7-1 (HT) - E8-4 (HA2A)
Below 1 Ω
A6-3 (AF+) or E8-22 (A1A+) - Body ground
A6-4 (AF-) or E8-30 (A1A-) - Body ground
A6-1 (HT) or E8-5 (HA1H) - Body ground
A7-3 (AF+) or E8-23 (A2A+) - Body ground
A7-4 (AF-) or E8-31 (A2A-) - Body ground
A7-1 (HT) or E8-4 (HA2A) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
AF-
E8
ECM
HA2A
A1A+
A1A-
HA1H
A2A+
A2A-
A88573
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Drawing)
A/F Relay
From
Battery
A/F
ECM
A/F Sensor
+B Heater HT
AF-
Sensor
HA1H
AF+
A1A+
Duty
Control
A1AMREL
A87980
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
6
(a)
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Check for vacuum leaks in air induction system.
OK: No leak in air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
828
05-639
DIAGNOSTICS
7
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE (See page 11-38 )
Check fuel pressure (high or low fuel pressure).
Standard:
Fuel pressure: 304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 50 psi).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
OK
8
(a)
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (See page 11-41 )
Check injector injection (high or low fuel injection quantity or poor injection pattern).
Standard:
Injection volume
Difference between each injector
60 to 73 cm3 (3.7 to 4.5 cu in.) per 15 seconds
13 cm3 (0.8 cu in.) or less
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
(See page 11-46 )
OK
9
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
10
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern.
GO
11
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (A/F SENSOR DTC OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result :
Display
Proceed to
A/F sensor circuit DTC are not output
A
A/F sensor circuit DTC are output
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 ) AND PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
829
05-640
DIAGNOSTICS
12
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
OK: Vehicle has run out of fuel in past.
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
YES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
13
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern.
GO
14
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (A/F SENSOR DTC OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
A/F sensor circuit DTC are output
A
A/F sensor circuit DTC are not output
B
B
Go to step 18
A
15
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
16
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern.
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
830
05-641
DIAGNOSTICS
17
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
READ OUTPUT DTC (A/F SENSOR DTC OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
A/F sensor circuit DTC are not output
A
A/F sensor circuit DTC are output
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 ) AND PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
A
18
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
OK: Vehicle has run out of fuel in past.
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
YES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
831
05-642
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EY2-06
DTC
P2238
OXYGEN SENSOR PUMPING CURRENT
CIRCUIT LOW (FOR A/F SENSOR)(BANK 1
SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2239
OXYGEN SENSOR PUMPING CURRENT
CIRCUIT HIGH (FOR A/F SENSOR)(BANK 1
SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2241
OXYGEN SENSOR PUMPING CURRENT
CIRCUIT LOW (FOR A/F SENSOR)(BANK 2
SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2242
OXYGEN SENSOR PUMPING CURRENT
CIRCUIT HIGH (FOR A/F SENSOR)(BANK 2
SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2252
OXYGEN SENSOR REFERENCE GROUND
CIRCUIT LOW (FOR A/F SENSOR)(BANK 1
SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2253
OXYGEN SENSOR REFERENCE GROUND
CIRCUIT HIGH (FOR A/F SENSOR)(BANK 1
SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2255
OXYGEN SENSOR REFERENCE GROUND
CIRCUIT LOW (FOR A/F SENSOR)(BANK 2
SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2256
OXYGEN SENSOR REFERENCE GROUND
CIRCUIT HIGH (FOR A/F SENSOR)(BANK 2
SENSOR 1)
HINT:
Although the title (DTC description) says ”oxygen sensor”, this DTC is related to the ”A/F sensor”.
DTC P2238, P2239, P2252 and P2253 refer to the malfunction related to the bank 1 A/F sensor circuit.
DTC P2241, P2242, P2255 and P2256 refer to the malfunction related to the bank 2 A/F sensor circuit.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
832
05-643
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-629 .
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit low
A/F sensor admittance is less than 0.022 1/Ω
(2 trip detection logic)
HINT: Main trouble area
P2238
P2241
Condition (a) continues for 5.0 seconds or more :
(a) A/F sensor admittance is less than 0.022 1/Ω
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
P2239
P2242
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit high
(2 trip detection logic)
HINT: Main trouble area
Short in A/F sensor circuit
Condition (a) continues for 5.0 seconds or more :
(a) AF+ is more than 4.5 V
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
Condition (a) continues for 5.0 seconds or more :
(a) (AF+) - (AF-) is more than 0.8 V
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
P2252
P2255
Condition (a) continues for 5.0 seconds or more :
(a) AF- is 0.5 V or less
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
P2253
P2256
Condition (a) continues for 5.0 seconds or more :
(a) AF- is more than 4.5 V
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
P2238
P2241
P2239
P2242
P2239
P2242
HINT:
Bank 1 is the bank that includes cylinder No.1.
Bank 2 is the bank that includes cylinder No.2.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor varies its voltage output in proportion to the air-fuel ratio. If impedance (alternating current resistance) or voltage output of the sensor deviates greatly from the standard, the ECM
determines that an open or short is in the A/F sensor circuit.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
833
05-644
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2238: A/F sensor (bank 1) open circuit between AF+ and AFP2238: A/F sensor (bank 1) short circuit between AF+ and AFP2238: A/F sensor (bank 1) short circuit between AF+ and GND
P2239: A/F sensor (bank 1) short circuit between AF+ and+B
P2241: A/F sensor (bank 2) open circuit betrween AF+ and AFP2241: A/F sensor (bank 2) short circuit between AF+ and AFP2241: A/F sensor (bank 2) short circuit between AF+ and GND
P2242: A/F sensor (bank 2) short circuit between AF+ and +B
P2252: A/F sensor (bank 1) short circuit between AF-and GND
P2253: A/F sensor (bank 1) short circuit between AF-and +B
P2253: A/F sensor (bank 2) short circuit between AF- and GND
P2256: A/F sensor (bank 2) short circuit between AF- and +B
Required sensors / components (Main)
A/F sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
ECT sensor, CKP sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 seconds: A/F sensor open circuit between AF+ and AF= P2238, P2241
5 seconds: Others
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
See page 05-377
P2238, P2241 (A/F sensor open circuit between AF+ and AF-):
Duration while all of the following conditions are met:
20 seconds or more
AF+ terminal voltage
0.5 to 4.5 V
AF- terminal voltage
0.5 to 4.5 V
Difference between AF+ terminal and AF- terminal voltages
0.1 to 0.8 V
ECT
20C (68F) or more
Engine condition
Running
Time after engine start
20 seconds or more
Fuel-cut
OFF
A/F sensor heater duty cycle
0 % or more
Time after A/F sensor heating
20 seconds or more
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
Others:
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Ignition switch
ON
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
834
05-645
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2238, P2241 (A/F sensor open circuit between AF+ and AF-):
A/F sensor admittance
Below 0.022 1/ohm
P2238, P2241 (A/F sensor short circuit between AF+ and GND):
AF+ terminal voltage
0.5 V or less
P2238, P2241 (A/F sensor short circuit between AF+ and AF-):
Difference between AF+ terminal and AF- terminal voltages
0.1 V or less
P2239, P2242 (A/F sensor short circuit between AF+ and +B):
AF+ terminal voltage
More than 4.5 V
P2252, P2255 (A/F sensor short circuit between AF- and GND):
AF- terminal voltage
0.5 V or less
P2253, P2256 (A/F sensor short circuit between AF- and +B):
AF- terminal voltage
More than 4.5 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-629 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
The malfunctioning area can be found by the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation. The A/F CONTROL
operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other suspected trouble areas are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume by 12.5% or increases the injection volume by
25%.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(5) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine idling (press the right or left button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: Less than 0.4 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
835
05-646
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Output voltage of A/F sensor
(sensor 1)
Output voltage of heated oxygen
sensor (sensor 2)
Injection volume
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 1 Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
OK
More than 0.55 V
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 2 Output voltage
A/F sensor
(A/F sensor, heater, A/F sensor circuit)
Output voltage
NG
Injection volume
More than 0.55 V
OK
Less than 0.4V
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 3 Output voltage
Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
OK
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
NG
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 4 Output voltage
Almost
No reaction
OK
Less than 0.4V
+25 %
Less than 3.0V
Output voltage
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Mainly suspected
Trouble Area
Output voltage
NG
Almost
No reaction
NG
Heated oxygen sensor
(heated oxygen sensor,
heater, heated oxygen sensor
circuit)
Extremely rich or lean actual
air-fuel ratio
(Injector, fuel pressure, gas
leakage in exhaust system,
etc.)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables the technician to check and graph the voltage outputs of
both the A/F sensor and the heated oxygen sensor.
For displaying the graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2” by pressing ”YES” and push ”ENTER”. Then press ”F4”.
HINT:
If DTC P2238, P2239, P2252 or P2253 is displayed, check the bank 1 sensor 1 circuit.
If DTC P2241, P2242, P2255 or P2256 is displayed, check the bank 2 sensor 1 circuit.
Read freeze frame data using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
836
05-647
DIAGNOSTICS
1
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
AF-
Disconnect the A6 or A7 A/F sensor connector.
Check the resistance of the A/F sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
20C (68F)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
-
10 kΩ or higher
AF+
A52607
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
2
INSPECT RELAY (A/F)
1
3
(a)
(b)
2
5
5
2
Remove the A/F relay from the engine room R/B No. 2.
Check the resistance of the A/F relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
1
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
837
05-648
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
HT
+B
A6 (Bank 1)
A7 (Bank 2)
A/F Sensor
AF+
Disconnect the A6 or A7 A/F sensor connector.
Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
AF-
E8
ECM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A6-3 (AF+) - E8-22 (A1A+)
A6-4 (AF-) - E8-30 (A1A-)
A6-1 (HT) - E8-5 (HA1H)
A7-3 (AF+) - E8-23 (A2A+)
A7-4 (AF-) - E8-31 (A2A-)
A7-1 (HT) - E8-4 (HA2A)
Below 1 Ω
A6-3 (AF+) or E8-22 (A1A+) - Body ground
A6-4 (AF-) or E8-30 (A1A-) - Body ground
A6-1 (HT) or E8-5 (HA1H) - Body ground
A7-3 (AF+) or E8-23 (A2A+) - Body ground
A7-4 (AF-) or E8-31 (A2A-) - Body ground
A7-1 (HT) or E8-4 (HA2A) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HA2A
A1A+
A1A-
HA1H
A2A+
A2A-
A88573
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Drawing)
A/F Relay
From
Battery
A/F
ECM
A/F Sensor
+B Heater HT
AF-
Sensor
HA1H
AF+
A1A+
Duty
Control
A1AMREL
A87980
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
838
05-649
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EY3-06
DTC
P2A00
A/F SENSOR CIRCUIT SLOW RESPONSE
(BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
DTC
P2A03
A/F SENSOR CIRCUIT SLOW RESPONSE
(BANK 2 SENSOR 1)
HINT:
DTC P2A00 refers to a malfunction related to the bank 1 A/F sensor.
DTC P2A03 refers to a malfunction related to the bank 2 A/F sensor.
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-629 .
DTC No.
P2A00
P2A03
DTC Detection Condition
In conditions (a), (b), and (c), when A/F sensor output voltage
change value is below regular value against fuel trim change
value, ECM judges that A/F sensor has slow response:
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Engine is warmed up
(b) Engine speed 1,400 rpm or more
(c) Vehicle speed 40 km/h (25 mph) or more
Trouble Area
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
PCV hose connection
ECM
HINT:
Bank 1 is the bank that includes cylinder No.1.
Bank 2 is the bank that includes cylinder No.2.
Sensor 1 is the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
839
05-650
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Locus length
A/F output (V)
Fuel trim
Fast sensor
Slow sensor
A82390
The Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor varies its output voltage in proportion to the air-fuel ratio. Based on the output voltage, the ECM determines if the air-fuel ratio is RICH or LEAN and adjusts the stoichiometric air-fuel
ratio. The ECM also checks the fuel injection volume compensation value to check if the A/F sensor is deteriorating or not. The output voltage variation, known as locus length, should be high when the air-fuel ratio
fluctuates. When the A/F sensor response rate has deteriorated, the locus length should be short.
The ECM concludes that there is a malfunction in the ratio of the A/F sensor when the locus length is short
and the response rate has deteriorated.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2A00: A/F Sensor (Bank 1) Slow Response
P2A03: A/F Sensor (Bank 2) Slow Response
Required sensors / components (Main)
A/F sensor
Required sensors / components (Related)
VSS, CKP sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
60 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence operation
None
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
840
05-651
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever this DTC is not present
See page 05-377
Engine condition
Running
Time after engine start
120 seconds or more
Fuel system status
Closed Loop
A/F sensor status
Activated
Idle
OFF
Time after idle OFF
2 seconds or more
Engine RPM
1,400 to 3,200 rpm
Vehicle speed
60 to 120 km/h (37.5 to 75 mph)
Fuel cut
OFF
Time after fuel cut is OFF
2 seconds or more
Driving for 20 seconds or more
40 km/h (25 mph) or more and 900 rpm or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Response rate deterioration level
6.0 or more
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to page 05-385 for detailed information.
The test value and test limit information are described as shown in the following table. Check the monitor
result and test values after performing the monitor drive pattern (see page 05-387 ).
TID (Test Identification Data) is assigned to each emissions-related component.
TLT (Test Limit Type):
If TLT is 0, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is higher than the test limit.
If TLT is 1, the component is malfunctioning when the test value is lower than the test limit.
CID (Component Identification Data) is assigned to each test value.
Unit Conversion is used to calculate the test value indicated on generic OBD ll scan tools.
TID $06: A/F sensor
TLT
CID
Unit Conversion
0
$01
Multiply by 0.000244
(no dimension)
0
$11
Multiply by 0.000244
(no dimension)
Description of Test Data
Description of Test Limit
Parameter for identify A/F sensor response
rate (Bank 1)
Malfunction threshold for A/F sensor deterioration
Parameter for identify A/F sensor response
rate (Bank 2)
Malfunction threshold for A/F sensor deterioration
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 on page 05-629 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Hand-held tester only:
The malfunctioning area can be found by the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation. The A/F CONTROL
operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other suspected trouble areas are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume by 12.5 % or increases the injection volume by
25%.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
841
05-652
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
(5) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine idling (press the right or left button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25 % → RICH output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5 % → LEAN output: Less than 0.4 V
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Output voltage of A/F sensor
(sensor 1)
Output voltage of heated oxygen
sensor (sensor 2)
Injection volume
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 1 Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
OK
More than 0.55 V
Injection volume
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 2 Output voltage
A/F sensor
(A/F sensor, heater, A/F sensor circuit)
Output voltage
NG
Injection volume
More than 0.55 V
OK
Less than 0.4V
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 3 Output voltage
Output voltage
More than 3.35 V
OK
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
NG
Injection volume
+25 %
+25 %
-12.5 %
-12.5 %
Case 4 Output voltage
Almost
No reaction
OK
Less than 0.4V
+25 %
Less than 3.0V
Output voltage
Injection volume
Almost
No reaction
Mainly suspected
Trouble Area
Output voltage
NG
Almost
No reaction
NG
Heated oxygen sensor
(heated oxygen sensor,
heater, heated oxygen sensor
circuit)
Extremely rich or lean actual
air-fuel ratio
(Injector, fuel pressure, gas
leakage in exhaust system,
etc.)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables the technician to check and graph the voltage outputs of
both the A/F sensor and the heated oxygen sensor.
For displaying the graph, enter ”ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL / USER DATA”, select ”AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2” by pressing ”YES” and push ”ENTER”. Then press ”F4”.
HINT:
DTC P2A00 or P2A03 may be also detected, when the air fuel ratio is stuck rich or lean.
A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a RICH air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run with a RICH air-fuel mixture.
A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a LEAN air-fuel mixture. Check for conditions that would
cause the engine to run with a LEAN air-fuel mixture.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
842
05-653
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Read freeze frame data using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool. Freeze frame data records
the engine conditions when a malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can
help determine if the vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel
ratio was lean or rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
(a)
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO A/F SENSOR DTC)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
DTC P2A00 and/or P2A03 are output.
A
DTC P2A00 and/or P2A03 and other codes are output.
B
HINT:
If any other code besides P2A00 and/or P2A03 are output, perform the troubleshooting for those codes first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
(See page 05-412 )
A
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
READ VALUE OF HAND-HELD TESTER OR OBD II SCAN TOOL (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF A/F SENSOR)
Connect the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
Warm up the A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1 and bank 2 sensor 1) by running the engine at 2,500 rpm
for approximately 90 seconds.
Read A/F sensor voltage output on the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Hand-held tester only:
On the hand-held tester, enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / SNAPSHOT
/ MANUAL SNAPSHOT / USER DATA. Read the values.
Select ”AFS B1 S1 or AFS B2 S1 / ENGINE SPD” and press YES.
Monitor the A/F sensor voltage carefully.
Check the A/F sensor voltage output under the following conditions:
(1) Allow the engine to idle for 30 seconds.
(2) Run the engine at approximately 2,500 rpm. Do not suddenly change the rpm.
(3) Raise the engine speed to 4,000 rpm and quickly release the accelerator pedal so that the throttle
is fully closed.
Standard:
Condition (1) and (2)
Voltage change of 3.3 V (0.66 V)* (between approximately 3.1 to 3.5 V) as shown in the illustration.
Condition (3)
A/F sensor voltage increases to 3.8 V (0.76 V)* or more when fuel is cut during engine deceleration as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
*: Voltage when using the OBD II scan tool.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
843
05-654
DIAGNOSTICS
Normal Condition
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Malfunction Condition
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(3) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(2) Approximately 2,500 rpm
(1) Idle
A/F
Sensor
Voltage
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
Engine
RPM
Engine
RPM
”Condition (3)”
3.8 V or More
A/F
Sensor
Voltage
Fuel Cut
Fuel Cut
”Condition (1), (2)”
Change of approximately 3.3 V
When A/F sensor circuit is malfunctioning,
voltage output does not change
A72304
HINT:
Whenever the A/F sensor output voltage remains at approximately 3.3 V (0.660 V)* (see ”Malfunction
Condition” graphic) under any condition as well as the above conditions, the A/F sensor may have an
open circuit. This will happen also when the A/F sensor heater has an open circuit.
Whenever the A/F sensor output voltage remains at a certain value of approximately 3.8 V (0.76 V)*
or more, or 2.8 V (0.56 V)* or less (see ”Malfunction Condition” graphic) under any condition as well
as the above conditions, the A/F sensor may have a short circuit.
The ECM will stop fuel injection (fuel is cut) during engine deceleration. This will cause a LEAN condition and should result in a momentary increase in A/F sensor output voltage.
The ECM must establish a closed throttle position learned value to perform fuel cut. If the battery terminal has been disconnected, the vehicle must be driven over 10 mph to allow the ECM to learn the
closed throttle position.
When the vehicle is driven:
The output voltage of the A/F sensor may be below 2.8 V (0.76 V)* during fuel enrichment. For the
vehicle, this translates to a sudden increase in speed with the accelerator pedal fully depressed when
trying to overtake another vehicle. The A/F sensor is functioning normally.
The A/F sensor is a current output element, and therefore the current is converted into voltage inside
the ECM. If measuring voltage at connectors of A/F sensor or ECM, you will observe a constant voltage.
*: Voltage when using the OBD II scan tool.
OK
Go to step 14
NG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
844
05-655
DIAGNOSTICS
3
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a)
(b)
AF-
Disconnect the A6 or A7 A/F sensor connector.
Check the resistance of the A/F sensor terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
20C (68F)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
-
10 kΩ or higher
AF+
A52607
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
4
INSPECT RELAY (A/F)
1
3
(a)
(b)
2
5
5
2
Remove the A/F relay from the engine room R/B No. 2.
Check the resisitance of the A/F relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
1
3
B60778
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
845
05-656
DIAGNOSTICS
5
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
Wire Harness Side
HT
+B
A6 (Bank 1)
A7 (Bank 2)
A/F Sensor
Disconnect the A6 or A7 A/F sensor connector.
Disconnect the E8 ECM connector.
Check the resistance of the wire harness side connectors.
Standard:
Tester Connection
AF+
A6-3 (AF+) A6-4 (AF-) A6-1 (HT) A7-3 (AF+) A7-4 (AF-) A7-1 (HT) -
AF-
Specified Condition
E8-22 (A1A+)
E8-30 (A1A-)
E8-5 (HA1H)
E8-23 (A2A+)
E8-31 (A2A-)
E8-4 (HA2A)
Below 1 Ω
A6-3 (AF+) or E8-22 (A1A+) - Body ground
A6-4 (AF-) or E8-30 (A1A-) - Body ground
A6-1 (HT) or E8-5 (HA1H) - Body ground
A7-3 (AF+) or E8-23 (A2A+) - Body ground
A7-4 (AF-) or E8-31 (A2A-) - Body ground
A7-1 (HT) or E8-4 (HA2A) - Body ground
E8
ECM
10 kΩ or higher
HA2A
A1A+
A1A-
HA1H
A2A+
A2A-
A88573
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Drawing)
A/F Relay
From
Battery
A/F
ECM
A/F Sensor
+B Heater HT
AF-
Sensor
HA1H
AF+
A1A+
Duty
Control
A1AMREL
A87980
NG
REPAIR OR
CONNECTOR
REPLACE
HARNESS
AND
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
846
05-657
DIAGNOSTICS
6
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Check for vacuum leaks in the air induction system.
OK: There is no leak in air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
OK
7
CHECK CONNECTION OF PCV HOSE
OK: PCV hose is connected correctly. And PCV hose has no damage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
8
(a)
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE (See page 11-38 )
Check fuel pressure (high or low fuel pressure).
Standard:
Fuel pressure: 304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 55 psi)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
OK
9
(a)
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (See page 11-41 )
Check injector injection (high or low fuel injection quantity or poor injection pattern).
Standard:
Injection volume
Difference between each injector
60 to 73 cm3 (3.7 to 4.5 cu in.) per 15 seconds
13 cm3 (0.8 cu in.) or less
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
(See page 11-46 )
OK
10
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
11
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (See page 05-629 )
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern (see page 05-629 ).
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
847
05-658
DIAGNOSTICS
12
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
READ OUTPUT DTC (A/F SENSOR DTC OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
DTC P2A00 and/or P2A03 are not output
A
DTC P2A00 and/or P2A03 are output again
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 ) AND PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(See page 05-629 )
A
13
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
YES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
14
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (See page 05-629 )
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern (see page 05-629 ).
GO
15
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (A/F SENSOR DTC OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
DTC P2A00 and/or P2A03 are not output
A
DTC P2A00 and/or P2A03 are output
B
B
Go to step 19
A
16
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
848
05-659
DIAGNOSTICS
17
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (See page 05-629 )
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving pattern (see page 05-629 ).
GO
18
(a)
READ OUTPUT DTC (A/F SENSOR DTC OUTPUT AGAIN)
Read the DTC using the hand-held tester or the OBD II scan tool.
Result:
Display
Proceed to
DTC P2A00 and/or P2A03 are output
A
DTC P2A00 and/or P2A03 are not output
B
B
REPLACE ECM (See page 10-24 ) AND PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN (See
page 05-629 )
A
19
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
OK: Vehicle has run out of fuel in past.
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(See page 05-370 )
YES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
849
05-387
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05C1K-10
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
1.
PURPOSE OF READINESS TESTS
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD II) system is designed to monitor the performance of emission-related components, and report any detected abnormalities with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
Since various components need to be monitored during different driving conditions, the OBD II system
is designed to run separate monitoring programs called readiness monitors.
The hand-held tester’s software must be version 9.0 or newer to view the readiness monitor status.
From the ”ENHANCED OBD II” menu, select ”MONITOR STATUS” to view the readiness monitor status.
A generic OBD II scan tool can also be used to view the readiness monitor status.
When the readiness monitor status reads ”complete”, the necessary conditions have been met for running performance tests for that readiness monitor.
HINT:
Many state Inspection and Maintenance (I/M) programs require a vehicle’s readiness monitor status to show
”complete”.
The Readiness Monitor will be reset to ”incomplete” if:
The ECM has lost battery power or blown a fuse.
DTCs have been cleared.
The conditions for running the Readiness Monitor have not been met.
If the readiness monitor status shows ”incomplete”, follow the appropriate readiness monitor drive pattern to change the status to ”complete”.
CAUTION:
Strictly observe of posted speed limits, traffic laws, and road conditions when performing these
drive patterns.
NOTICE:
The following drive patterns are the fastest method of completing all the requirements necessary for
making the readiness monitor status read ”complete”.
If forced to momentarily stop a drive pattern due to traffic or other factors, the drive pattern can be
resumed. Upon completion of the drive pattern, in most cases, the readiness monitor status will
change to ”complete”.
Sudden changes in vehicle load and speed, such as driving up and down hills and / or sudden acceleration, hinder readiness monitor completion.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
577
05-388
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CATALYST MONITOR (A/F SENSOR TYPE)
64 to 88 km/h
(40 to 55 mph)
64 to 80 km/h
(40 to 50 mph)
Idling
Ignition Switch OFF
Warm up time
(Idle Speed)
4 min.
16 min.
A82401
(a)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
The MIL is OFF.
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is 75°C (167°F) or greater.
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) is -10°C (14°F) or greater.*
NOTICE:
* 2002 and later MY vehicles:
To completed the readiness test in cold ambient conditions (less than -10°C / 14°F), turn the ignition
switch to the OFF position and then back to the ON position. Perform the drive pattern a second time.
(b) Drive Pattern
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool to DLC3 to check readiness monitor status and preconditions (refer
to step (a)).
(2) Drive vehicle at 64 to 88 km/h (40 to 55 mph) for approximately 4 minutes.
NOTICE:
Drive with smooth throttle operation and avoid sudden acceleration.
If IAT was less than 10°C (50°F) when the engine was started, drive the vehicle at 64 to 88 km/h (40
to 55 mph) for an additional 4 minutes.
(3) Drive vehicle allowing speed to fluctuate between 64 to 80 km/h (40 to 50 mph) for about 16 minutes.
NOTICE:
Drive with smooth throttle operation and avoid sudden closure of the throttle.
(4) Check the status of the readiness monitor on the scan tool display. If readiness monitor status
did not switch to complete, ensure preconditions are met, turn the ignition OFF, and then repeat
steps (2) and (3).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
578
05-389
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
3.
EVAP MONITOR (VACUUM PRESSURE MONITOR)
NOTICE:
A cold soak must be performed prior to conducting the drive pattern to complete the internal pressure readiness monitor.
(a) Cold Soak Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
The MIL is OFF.
Fuel level is approximately 1/2 to 3/4 full.
Altitude is 2,450 m (8,000 feet) or less.
(b) Cold Soak Procedure
Let vehicle cold soak for 8 hours or until ”IAT - ECT” must be -7°C (-13°F) to 11.1°C (20°F)
HINT:
Example 1
ECT = 24°C (75°F)
IAT = 16°C (60°F)
Difference between ECT and IAT is 8°C (15°F).
→ The monitor will not run because difference between ECT and IAT is greater than 7°C (13°F).
Example 2
ECT = 21°C (70°F)
IAT = 20°C (68°F)
Difference between ECT and IAT is 1°C (2°F).
→ The monitor will run because difference between ECT and IAT is less than 7°C (13°F).
3,000 rpm
Idling
Ignition Switch
OFF
Soak
10 sec.
Warm up time
(Idle speed)
15 to 50 min.
(When the readiness code or diagnostic code
is set, this test is completed.)
A78884
(c)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
The MIL is OFF.
Fuel level is approximately 1/2 to 3/4 full.
The altitude is 2,450 m (8,000 feet) or less.*
ECT is between 4.4°C and 35°C (40°F and 95°F).
IAT is between 4.4°C and 35°C (40°F and 95°F).*
The cold soak procedure has been completed.
Before starting the engine, the difference between ECT and IAT must be less than 7°C (13°F).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
579
05-390
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
HINT:
Example 1
ECT = 24°C (75°F)
IAT = 16°C (60°F)
Difference between ECT and IAT is 8°C (15°F).
→ The monitor will not run because difference between ECT and IAT is greater than 7°C (13°F).
Example 2
ECT = 21°C (70°F)
IAT = 20°C (68°F)
Difference between ECT and IAT is 1°C (2°F).
→ The monitor will run because difference between ECT and IAT is less than 7°C (13°F).
NOTICE:
* NOTE for 2002 and later MY vehicles:
The readiness test can be completed in cold ambient conditions (less than 4.4C / 40F) and / or high
altitudes (more than 2,450 m/8,000 feet). Finish the drive pattern, turn the ignition switch OFF and
then ON again, and repeat the drive pattern a second time.
(d) Drive Pattern
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions (refer to step
”a”).
(2) Release pressure in fuel tank by removing the fuel tank cap and then reinstalling it.
(3) Start the engine and allow it to idle until ECT is 75°C (167°F) or more.
(4) Run the engine at 3,000 rpm for about 10 seconds.
(5) With the engine idling, turn the A/C ON to create a slight electrical load. Wait 15 to 50 minutes.
NOTICE:
If the vehicle does not have A/C, put a slight electrical load on the engine by following the steps below:
Set the parking brake securely.
Use wheel chocks to secure the tires.
Move the shift lever to drive (position D) and allow engine to idle for 15 to 50 minutes.
Check the readiness monitor status.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
580
05-391
DIAGNOSTICS
4.
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
OXYGEN / A/F SENSOR MONITOR (FRONT A/F SENSOR AND REAR O2S SYSTEM)
112 km/h (70 mph)
(under 3,200 rpm)
64 km/h (40 mph)
(over 1,400 rpm)
Once
Twice
10 times
40 km/h (25 mph)
(over 900 rpm)
Idling
Ignition Switch OFF
Over
2 min.
(a)
(b)
Over
Over
Over
150 sec.
40 sec.
40 sec.
Over
Over
Over
10 sec.
10 sec.
10 sec.
Over
40 sec.
A82400
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
The MIL is OFF.
Drive Pattern
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions (refer to step
”a”).
(2) Start the engine and allow it to idle for 2 minutes or more.
(3) Drive the vehicle at 64 to 112 km/h (40 to 70 mph) for at least 150 seconds.
(4) Stop the vehicle and allow the engine to idle for 10 seconds or more.
(5) Drive the vehicle at 40 to 64 km/h (25 to 40 mph) for at least 40 seconds.
(6) Stop the vehicle and allow the engine to idle for 10 seconds or more.
(7) Perform steps (5) and (6) 10 times.
(8) Check the readiness monitor status. If the readiness monitor status did not change to ”complete”,
check the preconditions, turn the ignition switch OFF, and repeat steps (1) to (6).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
581
05-392
DIAGNOSTICS
5.
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
OXYGEN / A/F SENSOR HEATER MONITOR
40 km/h
(25 mph)
Idling
Ignition Switch OFF
Over 500 sec.
Over 2 min.
A78886
(a)
(b)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
The MIL is OFF.
Drive Pattern
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions (refer to step
”a”).
(2) Start the engine and allow it to idle for 500 seconds or more.
(3) Drive the vehicle at 40 km/h (25 mph) or more for at least 2 minutes.
(4) Check the readiness monitor status. If the readiness monitor status did not change to ”complete”,
check the preconditions, turn the ignition switch OFF, and repeat steps (2) to (3).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
582
05-373
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05MOL-01
REGISTRATION
NOTICE:
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) must be input into the replaced ECM.
HINT:
The VIN is a 17-digit alphanumeric vehicle identification number. A hand-held tester is required to register
the VIN.
1.
DESCRIPTION
This registration section consists of three parts, Input Instructions, Read VIN and Write VIN.
(a) Input Instructions: Explains the general VIN input instructions using a hand-held tester.
(b) Read VIN: Explains the VIN reading process in a flowchart. This process allows the VIN stored in the
ECM to be read, in order to confirm that the two VINs, provided with the vehicle and stored in the vehicle’s ECM, are the same.
(c) Write VIN: Explains the VIN writing process in a flowchart. This process allows the VIN to be input into
the ECM. If the ECM is changed, or the VINs do not match, the VIN can be registered, or overwritten
in the ECM by following this procedure.
2.
INPUT INSTRUCTIONS
(a) Hand-held tester
(1) The arrow buttons (UP, DOWN, RIGHT and LEFT) and numerical buttons (0 to 9) are used, in
order to input the VIN.
(b) Cursor Operation
(1) To move the cursor around the tester screen, press the RIGHT and LEFT buttons.
(c) Alphabetical Character Input
(1) Press the UP and DOWN buttons to select the desired alphabetical character.
(2) After selection, the cursor should move.
(d) Numeric Character Input
(1) Press the numerical button corresponding to the number that you want to input.
(2) After input, the cursor should move.
HINT:
Numerical characters can be selected by using the UP and DOWN buttons.
(e) Correction
(1) When correcting the input character(s), put the cursor onto the character using the RIGHT or
LEFT button.
(2) Select or input the correct character using the UP/DOWN buttons, or the numerical buttons.
(f)
Finishing Input Operation
(1) Make sure that the input VIN matches the vehicle VIN after input.
(2) Press the ENTER button on the tester.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
563
05-374
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
READ VIN (Vehicle Identification Number)
Read VIN using a hand-held tester.
READ:
START
Confirm vehicle VIN
Preparation:
1. Connect hand-held tester to DLC3
2. Turn ignition switch to ON
3. Turn tester ON
Hand-held tester operation:
1. Select DIAGNOSIS
2. Select ENHANCED OBD ll
3. Select VIN
Menu Screen:
VIN
Select VIN READ
1. VIN READ
2. VIN WRITE
DTC P0630 Set
ERROR
DTC P0630 was detected.
P0630 [VIN Not Programmed
or Mismatch - ECM/PCM]
ERROR
*********************************
[
VIN
]
*********************************
[EXIT]
ECM does not respond the VIN.
17-digit VIN
displayed
Please input the VIN.
PRESS [EXIT]
VIN Not Stored
VIN Previously Stored
PRESS [EXIT]
Possible cause:
1: VIN is not written yet.
2: Vehicle does not support this
function.
PRESS [EXIT]
[EXIT]
[EXIT]
To Menu Screen
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
564
05-375
DIAGNOSTICS
4.
(a)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
WRITE VIN
Write VIN using the hand-held tester.
Write:
START
Confirm vehicle VIN
Preparation:
1. Connect hand-held tester to DLC3
2. Turn ignition switch to ON
3. Turn tester ON
Hand-held tester operation:
1. Select DIAGNOSIS
2. Select ENHANCED OBD ll
3. Select VIN
Menu Screen:
VIN
Select VIN WRITE
1. VIN READ
1.
READ
2. VIN WRITE
CONFIRMATION
This function will erase the
DTCs automatically after
writing the VIN.
VIN Previously Stored
NOTICE
This function overwrites the
following VIN with a new VIN.
*********************************
Do you wish to continue?
[
VIN
]
*********************************
[YES] or [NO]
Do you wish to continue?
[NO]
[YES]
[YES] to Continue
[NO] to EXIT
[YES]
17-digit VIN displayed
To Menu
Screen
Continued on next page
[YES]
[NO]
To Menu Screen
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
565
05-376
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Continued from previous page
New Registration
SET NEW VIN
VIN input method
CONFIRMATION
Vehicle is stopped.
Engine is not running.
Input Instructions
[ENTER]
Press [RIGHT]/[LEFT] to shift
the cursor right/left.
Press [UP]/[DOWN] to
increase/decrease value.
Or, input digit with the 10 key.
PRESS [ENTER]
PRESS [ENTER]
[ENTER]
Input a new VIN
If you want to clear the VIN,
press [NO] key.
PRESS [ENTER]
[ENTER]
Input Error
INPUT ERROR
Your VIN is incorrect.
Please enter the VIN again.
NOW WRITING
[EXIT]
[EXIT] to RETURN
Writing Succeeded
WRITING COMPLETE
Writing Error
Communication Error
WRITING FAILED
COMMUNICATION ERROR
Turn IG OFF, then ON.
Please try again.
Turn IG OFF, then ON.
PRESS [EXIT]
PRESS [EXIT]
[EXIT]
[EXIT]
The following VIN has been
written correctly.
The DTCs have been erased
correctly.
PRESS [ENTER]
[ENTER]
To Menu Screen
To Menu Screen
To Menu Screen
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
566
05-363
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05EX1-05
PART AND SYSTEM NAME LIST
This reference list indicates the part names used in this manual along with their definitions.
TOYOTA/LEXUS name
Definition
Toyota HCAC system, Hydro-carbon Adsorptive Catalyst
(HCAC) system, HC adsorptive three-way catalyst
HC adsorptive three-way catalytic converter
Variable Valve Timing sensor, VVT sensor
Camshaft position sensor
Variable valve timing system, VVT system
Camshaft timing control system
Camshaft timing oil control valve, Oil control valve, OCV,
VVT, VSV
Camshaft timing oil control valve
Variable timing and lift, VVTL
Camshaft timing and lift control
Crankshaft position sensor ”A”
Crankshaft position sensor
Engine speed sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
THA
Intake air temperature
Knock control module
Engine knock control module
Knock sensor
Engine knock sensor
Mass or volume air flow circuit
Mass air flow meter circuit
Vacuum sensor
Manifold air pressure sensor
Internal control module, Control module, Engine control
ECU, PCM
Power train control module
FC idle
Deceleration fuel cut
Idle air control valve
Idle speed control
CCV, Canister close valve VSV for canister control
Evaporative emissions canister vent valve
EVAP VSV, Vacuum switching valve assembly No. 1, EVAP
VSV, Purge VSV
Evaporative emissions canister purge valve
VSV for pressure switching valve, Bypass VSV
Evaporative emission pressure switching valve
Vapor pressure sensor, EVAP pressure sensor, Evaporative
emission control system pressure sensor
Fuel tank pressure sensor
Charcoal canister
Evaporative emissions canister
ORVR system
On-board refueling vapor recovery system
Intake manifold runner control
Intake manifold tuning system
Intake manifold runner valve, IMRV, IACV (runner valve)
Intake manifold tuning valve
Intake control VSV
Intake manifold tuning solenoid valve
AFS
Air fuel ratio sensor
O2 sensor
Heater oxygen sensor
Oxygen sensor pumping current circuit
Oxygen sensor output signal
Oxygen sensor reference ground circuit
Oxygen sensor signal ground
Accel position sensor
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Throttle actuator control motor, Actuator control motor, Electronic throttle motor, Throttle control motor
Electronic throttle actuator
Electronic throttle control system, Throttle actuator control
system
Electronic throttle control system
Throttle/pedal position sensor, Throttle/pedal position switch,
Throttle position sensor/switch
Throttle position sensor
Turbo press sensor
Turbocharger pressure sensor
Turbo VSV
Turbocharger pressure control solenoid valve
P/S pressure switch
Power-steering pressure switch
VSV for ACM
Active control engine mount
Speed sensor, Vehicle speed sensor ”A”, Speed sensor for
skid control ECU
Vehicle speed sensor
ATF temperature sensor, Trans. fluid temp. sensor, ATF
temperature sensor ”A”
Transmission fluid temperature sensor
Electronic controlled automatic transmission, ECT
Electronically controlled automatic
Intermediate shaft speed sensor ”A”
Counter gear speed sensor
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
553
05-364
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
TOYOTA/LEXUS name
Definition
Output speed sensor
Output shaft speed sensor
Input speed sensor, Input turbine speed sensor ”A”, Speed
sensor (NT), Turbine speed sensor
Input turbine speed sensor
PNP switch, NSW
Park/neutral position switch
Pressure control solenoid
Transmission pressure control solenoid
Shift solenoid
Transmission shift solenoid valve
Transmission control switch, Shift lock control unit
Shift lock control module
Engine immobilizer system, Immobilizer system
Vehicle anti-theft system
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
554
05-369
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05289-40
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
Inspector’s
Name
SFI SYSTEM Check Sheet
VIN
Date Vehicle
Brought in
Production Date
Licence Plate No.
Odometer Reading
Problem Symptoms
Customer’s Name
Engine Does
Not Start
Engine does not crank
Difficult to
Start
Engine cranks slowly
Other
Poor Idling
Incorrect first idle
Idling rpm is abnormal
Rough idling
Other
Poor
Driveability
Hesitation
Knocking
Engine Stall
Soon after starting
After accelerator pedal depressed
After accelerator pedal released
During A/C operation
Shifting from N to D
Other
km
miles
No initial combustion
Backfire
Other
No complete combustion
High (
rpm)
Low (
Muffler explosion (after-fire)
rpm)
Surging
Other
Date Problem
Occurred
Condition When
Problem Occurs
Problem Frequency
Constant
Other
Sometimes (
times per
Weather
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Outdoor
Temperature
Hot
Warm
Cool
Place
Highway
Rough road
Engine Temp.
Cold
Engine Operation
Just after starting (
Starting
Driving
Constant speed
A/C switch ON/OFF
Other
Suburbs
Other
Warming up
Condition of Malfunction Indicator Light
(MIL)
Normal Mode
(Pre-check)
day/month)
Snowy
Various/Other
C/
Cold (approx.
Inner City
After Warming up
Once only
Uphill
F)
Downhill
Any temp.
min.)
Idling
Acceleration
Other
Racing
Deceleration
Remains on
Sometimes lights up
Does not light up
Normal
Malfunction code(s) (code
Freeze frame data (
)
Malfunction code(s) (code
Freeze frame data (
)
)
DTC Inspection
Check Mode
Normal
)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
559
05-412
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05284-46
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
Parameters listed in the chart may be different than your readings depending on the type of instrument used
and other factors.
During the DTC check, refer to the table below if a malfunction code is displayed. For details about each
code, refer to the page number in the DTC Chart’s left column.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
P0010
(05-422 )
Camshaft Position ”A” Actuator
Circuit (Bank 1)
Open or short in OCV (bank 1) circuit
OCV (bank 1)
ECM
P0011
(05-428 )
Camshaft Position ”A” -Timing
Over-Advanced or System Performance (Bank 1)
Valve timing
OCV (bank 1)
Camshaft timing gear assy
ECM
P0012
(05-428 )
Camshaft Position ”A” -Timing
Over- Retarded (Bank 1)
Same as DTC No. P0011
P0016
(05-436 )
Crankshaft Position - Camshaft
Position Correlation (Bank 1
Sensor A)
Mechanical system (Timing belt has jumped tooth, belt
stretched)
ECM
P0018
(05-436 )
Crankshaft Position - Camshaft
Position Correlation (Bank 2
Sensor A)
Same as DTC No. P0016
P0020
(05-422 )
Camshaft Position ”A” Actuator
Circuit (Bank 2)
Open or short in OCV (bank 2) circuit
OCV (bank 2)
ECM
P0021
(05-428 )
Camshaft Position ”A” -Timing
Over-Advanced or System Performance (Bank 2)
Valve timing
OCV (bank 2)
Camshaft timing gear assy
ECM
P0022
(05-428 )
Camshaft Position ”A” -Timing
Over- Retarded (Bank 2)
Same as DTC No. P0021
P0031*3
(05-438 )
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater
Control Circuit Low (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Open or short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F relay
ECM
P0032*3
(05-438 )
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater
Control Circuit High (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
Short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F relay
ECM
P0037
(05-443 )
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control
Circuit Low (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Open or short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 2)
EFI relay
ECM
P0038
(05-443 )
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control
Circuit High (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 2)
EFI relay
ECM
P0051*3
(05-438 )
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater
Control Circuit Low (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Open or short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 1)
A/F relay
ECM
P0052*3
(05-438 )
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater
Control Circuit High (Bank 2
Sensor 1)
Short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 1)
A/F relay
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
602
05-413
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
P0057
(05-443 )
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control
Circuit Low (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
Open or short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 2)
EFI relay
ECM
P0058
(05-443 )
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control
Circuit High (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
Short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 2)
EFI relay
ECM
P0100
(05-448 )
Mass or volume Air Flow Circuit
Open or short in MAF meter circuit
MAF meter
ECM
P0101
(05-455 )
Mass or volume Air Flow Circuit
Range/Performance Problem
MAF meter
P0102
(05-448 )
Mass or volume Air Flow Circuit
Low Input
Open in MAF meter circuit
Short in ground circuit
MAF meter
ECM
P0103
(05-448 )
Mass or volume Air Flow Circuit
High Input
Short in MAF meter circuit (to +B circuit)
MAF meter
ECM
P0110
(05-457 )
Intake Air Temperature Circuit
Open or short in IAT sensor circuit
IAT sensor (built in MAF meter)
ECM
P0112
(05-457 )
Intake Air Temperature Circuit
Low Input
Short in IAT sensor circuit
IAT sensor (built in MAF meter)
ECM
P0113
(05-457 )
Intake Air Temperature Circuit
High Input
Open in IAT sensor circuit
IAT sensor (built in MAF meter)
ECM
P0115
(05-462 )
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit
Open or short ECT sensor circuit
ECT sensor
ECM
P0116
(05-467 )
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Range/Performance Problem
ECT sensor
P0117
(05-462 )
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Low Input
Short in ECT sensor circuit
ECT sensor
ECM
P0118
(05-462 )
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit High Input
Open in ECT sensor circuit
ECT sensor
ECM
P0120
(05-469 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”A” Circuit
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
ECM
P0121
(05-478 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”A” Circuit Range/Performance Problem
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”A” Circuit Low Input
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
Short in VTA1 circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”A” Circuit High Input
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
Open in VTA1 circuit
Open in E2 circuit
VC and VTA1 circuits are short circuited
ECM
P0122
(05-469 )
P0123
(05-469 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
603
05-414
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
P0125
(05-480 )
Insufficient Coolant Temperature
for Closed Loop Fuel Control
P0128
(05-482 )
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MIL*1
Memory
Cooling system
ECT sensor
Thermostat
Coolant Thermostat (Coolant
Temperature Below Thermostat
Regulating Temperature)
Thermostat (water inlet)
Cooling system
ECT sensor
ECM
P0136
(05-485 )
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor circuit (bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1)
Oxygen sensor heater (bank 1)
A/F sensor (bank 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 1)
P0137
(05-485 )
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor circuit (bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1)
Oxygen sensor heater (bank 1)
P0138
(05-485 )
Oxygen Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor circuit (bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1)
Oxygen sensor heater (bank 1)
P0156
(05-485 )
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor circuit (bank 2)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 2)
Oxygen sensor heater (bank 2)
A/F sensor (bank 2)
A/F sensor heater (bank 2)
P0157
(05-485 )
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor circuit (bank 2)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 2)
Oxygen sensor heater (bank 2)
P0158
(05-485 )
Oxygen Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Bank 2 Sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor circuit (bank 2)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 2)
Oxygen sensor heater (bank 2)
System too Lean (Bank 1)
Air induction system
Injector blockage
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F relay
PCV valve and hose
PCV hose connection
System too Rich (Bank 1)
Injector leak, blockage
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Ignition system
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F relay
P0171
(05-498 )
P0172
(05-498 )
Trouble Area
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
604
05-415
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MIL*1
Memory
System too Lean (Bank 2)
Air induction system
Injector blockage
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 1)
A/F relay
PCV valve and hose
PCV hose connection
P0175
(05-498 )
System too Rich (Bank 2)
Injector leak, blockage
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Ignition system
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 2 sensor 1)
A/F relay
P0220
(05-469 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”B” Circuit
Same as DTC No. P0120
P0222
(05-469 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”B” Circuit Low Input
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
Short in VTA2 circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”B” Circuit High Input
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
Open in VTA2 circuit
Open in E2 circuit
VC and VTA2 circuits are short circuited
ECM
P0300
(05-511)
Random/Multiple Cylinder Misfire
Detected
Open or short in engine wire
Connector connection
Vacuum hose connection
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel pressure
MAF meter
ECT sensor
Compression pressure
Valve clearance
Valve timing
PCV hose connection
PCV hose
ECM
*2
P0301
(05-511)
Cylinder 1 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC No. P0300
*2
P0302
(05-511)
Cylinder 2 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC No. P0300
*2
P0303
(05-511)
Cylinder 3 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC No. P0300
*2
P0304
(05-511)
Cylinder 4 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC No. P0300
*2
P0305
(05-511)
Cylinder 5 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC No. P0300
*2
P0174
(05-498 )
P0223
(05-469 )
Detection Item
Trouble Area
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
605
05-416
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
*2
P0306
(05-511)
Cylinder 6 Misfire Detected
Same as DTC No. P0300
P0327
(05-527 )
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit Low
Input (Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
Short in knock sensor 1 circuit
Knock sensor 1
ECM
P0328
(05-527 )
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit High
Input (Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
Open in knock sensor 1 circuit
Knock sensor 1
ECM
P0332
(05-527 )
Knock Sensor 2 Circuit Low
Input (Bank 2)
Short in knock sensor 2 circuit
Knock sensor 2
ECM
P0333
(05-527 )
Knock Sensor 2 Circuit High
Input (Bank 2)
Open in knock sensor 2 circuit
Knock sensor 2
ECM
P0335
(05-532 )
Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A”
Circuit
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Crankshaft timing pulley
ECM
P0339
(05-532 )
Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A”
Circuit Intermittent
Same as DTC No. P0335
P0340
(05-536 )
Camshaft Position Sensor ”A”
Circuit (Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
Open or short in VVT sensor circuit
VVT sensor
Camshaft timing pulley
Timing belt has a jumped tooth
ECM
P0341
(05-536 )
Camshaft Position Sensor ”A”
Circuit Range/Performance
(Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
Same as DTC No. P0340
P0345
(05-536 )
Camshaft Position Sensor ”A”
Circuit (Bank 2)
Same as DTC No. P0340
P0346
(05-536 )
Camshaft Position Sensor ”A”
Circuit Range/Performance
(Bank 2)
Same as DTC No. P0340
Ignition Coil ”A” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF1 or IGT1 circuit from ignition coil with
igniter to ECM (ignition coil circuit 1)
Ignition coil with igniter (ignition coil 1)
ECM
Ignition Coil ”B” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF1 or IGT2 circuit from ignition coil with
igniter to ECM (ignition coil circuit 2)
Ignition coil with igniter (ignition coil 2)
ECM
Ignition Coil ”C” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF1 or IGT3 circuit from ignition coil with
igniter to ECM (ignition coil circuit 3)
Ignition coil with igniter (ignition coil 3)
ECM
Ignition Coil ”D” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF1 or IGT4 circuit from ignition coil with
igniter to ECM (ignition coil circuit 4)
Ignition coil with igniter (ignition coil 4)
ECM
Ignition Coil ”E” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF1 or IGT5 circuit from ignition coil with
igniter to ECM (ignition coil circuit 5)
Ignition coil with igniter (ignition coil 5)
ECM
P0351*4
(05-541 )
P0352*4
(05-541 )
P0353*4
(05-541 )
P0354*4
(05-541 )
P0355*4
(05-541 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
606
05-417
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
P0356*4
(05-541 )
Ignition Coil ”F” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF1 or IGT6 circuit from ignition coil with
igniter to ECM (ignition coil circuit 6)
Ignition coil with igniter (ignition coil 6)
ECM
P0420
(05-551 )
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold (Bank 1)
Gas leakage in exhaust system
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Three-way catalytic converter (inside exhaust manifold)
P0430
(05-551 )
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold (Bank 2)
Gas leakage in exhaust system
A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 2 sensor 2)
Three-way catalytic converter (inside exhaust manifold)
P0441
(05-557 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System
Incorrect Purge Flow
Vacuum hose has cracks, holes, or is blocked, damaged or
disconnected
Fuel tank cap is incorrectly installed
Fuel tank cap has cracks, or is damaged
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
Open or short in VSV circuit for EVAP
EVAP VSV
Open or short in VSV circuit for CCV
CCV
Fuel tank has cracks, holes, or is damaged
Charcoal canister has cracks, holes, or is damaged
Fuel tank over fill check valve has cracks, or is damaged
ECM
P0442
(05-563 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System Leak detected (small
leak)
Same as DTC No. P0441
P0446
(05-570 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System Vent Control Circuit
Same as DTC No. P0441
P0451
(05-573 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure Sensor/Switch
Range/Performance
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
ECM
P0452
(05-573 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure Sensor/Switch
Low Input
Open in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
ECM
P0453
(05-573 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure Sensor/Switch
High Input
Short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
ECM
P0455
(05-563 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System Leak Detected (gross
leak)
Same as DTC No. P0441
P0456
(05-563 )
Evaporative Emission Control
System Leak Detected (very
small leak)
Same as DTC No. P0441
P0500
(05-578 )
Vehicle Speed Sensor ”A”
Open or short in VSS circuit
VSS sensor
Combination meter
ECM
Skid control ECU
P0503
(05-578 )
Vehicle Speed Sensor ”A” Intermittent/Erratic/High
Same as DTC No. P0500
P0504
(05-581 )
Brake Switch ”A”/”B” Correlation
Short in stop lamp switch signal circuit
Stop lamp switch
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
607
05-418
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
P0505
(05-587 )
Idle Air Control System
Electric throttle control system
Air induction system
PCV hose connection
P0560
(05-590 )
System Voltage
Open in back-up power source circuit
ECM
P0604
(05-593 )
Internal Control Module Random
Access Memory (RAM) Error
ECM
P0606
(05-593 )
ECM/PCM Processor
ECM
P0607
(05-593 )
Control Module Performance
ECM
P0617
(05-595 )
Starter Relay Circuit High
Short in PNP switch circuit
PNP switch
Ignition switch
ECM
P0630
(05-601 )
VIN not Programmed or Mismatch - ECM/PCM
ECM
P0657
(05-593 )
Actuator Supply Voltage Circuit /
Open
ECM
P0705
(05-1036 )
Transmission Range Sensor Circuit Malfunction (PRNDL Input)
Short in PNP switch circuit
PNP switch
ECM
P0710
(05-1042 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Circuit
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0711
(05-1046 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Performance
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0712
(05-1042 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Circuit Low Input
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0713
(05-1042 )
Transmission Fluid Temperature
Sensor ”A” Circuit High Input
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0717
(05-1049 )
Input/Turbine Speed Sensor ”A”
Circuit No Signal
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0724
(05-1052 )
Brake Switch ”B” Circuit High
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0741
(05-1056 )
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Performance (Shift Solenoid
Valve DSL)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0746
(05-1061 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”A”
Performance (Shift Solenoid
Valve SL1)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0748
(05-1065 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”A”
Electrical (Shift Solenoid Valve
SL1)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0766
(05-1068 )
Shift Solenoid ”D” Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve S4)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0771
(05-1072 )
Shift Solenoid ”E” Performance
(Shift Solenoid Valve SR)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0776
(05-1077 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”B”
Performance (Shift Solenoid
Valve SL2)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0778
(05-1082 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”B”
Electrical (Shift Solenoid Valve
SL2)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0793
(05-1085 )
Intermediate Shaft Speed Sensor ”A” Circuit No Signal
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
608
05-419
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
P0796
(05-1089 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”C”
Performance (Shift Solenoid
Valve SL3)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0798
(05-1094 )
Pressure Control Solenoid ”C”
Electrical (Shift Solenoid Valve
SL3)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0982
(05-1097 )
Shift Solenoid ”D” Control Low
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0983
(05-1097 )
Shift Solenoid ”D” Control High
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0985
(05-1100)
Pressure Control Solenoid ”E”
Performance (Shift Solenoid
Valve SR)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P0986
(05-1100)
Pressure Control Solenoid ”E”
Electrical (Shift Solenoid Valve
SR)
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P2102
(05-603 )
Throttle Actuator Control Motor
Circuit Low
Open in throttle control motor circuit
Throttle control motor
ECM
P2103
(05-603 )
Throttle Actuator Control Motor
Circuit High
Short in throttle control motor circuit
Throttle control motor
Throttle body
Throttle valve
ECM
P2111
(05-607 )
Throttle Actuator Control System
- Stuck Open
Throttle control motor circuit
Throttle control motor
Throttle body
Throttle valve
P2112
(05-607 )
Throttle Actuator Control System
- Stuck Closed
Same as DTC No. P2111
P2118
(05-610 )
Throttle Actuator Control Motor
Current Range/Performance
Open in ETCS power source circuit
ECM
P2119
(05-615 )
Throttle Actuator Control Throttle
Body Range/Performance
ETCS
ECM
P2120
(05-617 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”D” Circuit
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
P2121
(05-625 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”D” Circuit Range/Performance
Open or short in accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
P2122
(05-617 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”D” Circuit Low Input
Accelerator pedal position sensor
VCP1 circuit open
VPA1 circuit open or ground short
ECM
P2123
(05-617 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”D” Circuit High Input
Accelerator pedal position sensor
EPA circuit open
ECM
P2125
(05-617 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”E” Circuit
Same as DTC No. P2120
P2127
(05-617 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”E” Circuit Low Input
Accelerator pedal position sensor
VCP2 circuit open
VPA2 circuit open or ground short
ECM
P2128
(05-617 )
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”E” Circuit High Input
Accelerator pedal position sensor
EPA2 circuit open
ECM
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
609
05-420
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
P2135
(05-469 )
Throttle Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”A”/”B” Voltage Correlation
VTA1 and VTA2 circuit are short circuited
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
ECM
P2138
(05-617 )
Throttle Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”D”/”E” Voltage Correlation
VPA1 and VPA2 circuit are short circuited
Accelerator pedal position sensor
ECM
P2195*3
(05-629 )
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal
Stuck Lean (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) heater
A/F relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
PCV hose connection
ECM
P2196*3
(05-629 )
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal
Stuck Rich (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P2195
P2197*3
(05-629 )
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal
Stuck Lean (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1) heater
A/F relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
PCV hose connection
ECM
P2198*3
(05-629 )
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal
Stuck Rich (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P2197
P2238*3
(05-642 )
Oxygen Sensor Pumping Current Circuit Low (for A/F sensor)
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) heater
A/F relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
ECM
P2239*3
(05-642 )
Oxygen Sensor Pumping Current Circuit High (for A/F sensor)
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P2238
P2241*3
(05-642 )
Oxygen Sensor Pumping Current Circuit Low (for A/F sensor)
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1) heater
A/F relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuit
ECM
P2242*3
(05-642 )
Oxygen Sensor Pumping Current Circuit High (for A/F sensor)
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P2241
P2252*3
(05-642 )
Oxygen Sensor Reference
Ground Circuit Low (for A/F sensor) (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P2238
P2253*3
(05-642 )
Oxygen Sensor Reference
Ground Circuit High (for A/F sensor) (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P2238
P2255*3
(05-642 )
Oxygen Sensor Reference
Ground Circuit Low (for A/F sensor) (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P2241
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
610
05-421
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
P2256*3
(05-642 )
Oxygen Sensor Reference
Ground Circuit High (for A/F sensor) (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
P2716
(05-1103)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
MIL*1
Memory
Same as DTC No. P2241
Pressure Control Solenoid ”D”
Electrical
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P2769
(05-1106)
DSL Solenoid Circuit Low
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
P2770
(05-1106)
DSL Solenoid Circuit High
Electronic controlled automatic transmission (ECT)
A/F Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
PCV hose connection
ECM
A/F Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
A/F relay
Open or short in A/F sensor heater and relay circuits
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
PCV hose connection
ECM
P2A00
(05-649 )
P2A03
(05-649 )
Trouble Area
HINT:
*1: MIL is illuminated.
*2: MIL is illuminated or flashes continuously.
*3: Although the title (DTC description) says ”oxygen sensor”, this DTC is related to the ”A/F sensor”.
*4: This DTC indicates a malfunction related to primary circuit.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
611
05-366
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05288-42
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
The hand-held tester is used in steps 3, 4, 5, 7 and 10.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS (See page 05-369 )
NEXT
3
CONNECT HAND-HELD TESTER TO DLC3
HINT:
If the display indicates a communication fault in the tool, inspect DLC3.
NEXT
4
CHECK DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA (See page 05-400 )
HINT:
Record or print DTC and freeze frame data, if needed.
NEXT
5
CLEAR DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA (See page 05-400 )
NEXT
6
VISUAL INSPECTION
NEXT
7
SETTING CHECK (TEST) MODE DIAGNOSIS (See page 05-402 )
NEXT
8
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
HINT:
If the engine does not start, perform steps 10 and 12 first.
B
Malfunction does not occur
A
Malfunction occurs
B
Go to step 10
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
556
05-367
DIAGNOSTICS
9
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
10
DTC CHECK (See page 05-400 )
B
Malfunction code
A
No code
B
Go to step 12
A
11
DTC CHART (See page 05-412 )
NEXT
Go to step 14
12
BASIC INSPECTION (See page 05-371 )
B
Wrong parts not confirmed
A
Wrong parts confirmed
B
Go to step 17
A
13
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE (See page 05-393 )
B
Wrong circuit confirmed
A
Wrong parts confirmed
B
Go to step 17
A
14
CHECK ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT (See page 05-674 )
NEXT
15
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
B
Malfunction not confirmed
A
Malfunction confirmed
B
Go to step 18
A
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
557
05-368
DIAGNOSTICS
16
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS (See page 05-370 )
NEXT
Go to step 18
17
PARTS INSPECTION
NEXT
18
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
19
ADJUSTMENT, REPAIR
NEXT
20
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
558
05-365
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05285-43
LOCATION
Combination Meter Assy
Charcoal Canister Assy
Charcoal Canister Filter
CCV
Vapor Pressure
Sensor Assy
Center J/B
Mass Air Flow Meter
ECM
Fuel Pump
Passenger Side J/B
VSV for ACM
Engine Room R/B No.2,
J/B and FL Block Assy
A/F Relay
EFI Relay
EFI NO. 1 Fuse
ETCS Fuse
DLC3
Engine Coolant
Temperature Sensor
EVAP VSV
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
R/B Sub-assy
IGN Fuse
IG2 Fuse
C/OPN Relay
Accelerator Pedal Rod Assy
(Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor)
Knock Sensor (Bank 2)
IAC Valve No. 2
Knock Sensor (Bank 1)
Injector
Ignition Coil Assy
Throttle Body Assy
(Throttle Position
Sensor and Motor)
Camshaft Timing Oil
Control Valve Assy
(Bank 2)
Camshaft Timing Oil
Control Valve Assy
(Bank 1)
VVT Sensor (Bank 2)
VVT Sensor (Bank 1)
A/F Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
A/F Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
A89566
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
555
05-393
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05287-44
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspected Area
See Page
Engine does not crank (does not start)
1. Starter
2. Starter relay
3. PNP switch
19-36
19-36
40-11
No initial combustion (does not start)
1. ECM power source circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
3. ECM
05-674
05-717
01-36
No complete combustion (does not start)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
05-717
Difficult to start (engine cranks normally)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
3. Compression
05-595
05-717
14-121
Difficult to start with cold engine
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
05-595
05-717
Difficult to start with hot engine
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
05-595
05-717
High engine idle speed (poor idling)
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor circuit)
2. ECM power source circuit
05-1190
05-674
Low engine idle speed (poor idling)
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor circuit)
2. Fuel pump control circuit
05-1190
05-717
Rough idling (poor idling)
1. Compression
2. Fuel pump control circuit
14-121
05-717
Hunting (poor idling)
1. ECM power source circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
05-674
05-717
Hesitation/Poor acceleration (poor driveability)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
2. A/T faulty
05-717
05-1016
Surging (poor driveability)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
05-717
Engine stalls soon after starting
1. Fuel pump control circuit
05-717
Engine stalls during A/C operation
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor circuit)
2. ECM
05-1190
01-36
Unable to refuel/Difficult to refuel
1. ORVR system
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
583
05-394
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
05286-32
TERMINALS OF ECM
E7
E8
E9
E6
E5
A53766
Each ECM terminal’s standard voltage is shown in the table below.
In the table, first follow the information under ”Condition”. Next look under ”Symbols (Terminal No.)” for the
terminals to be inspected. The standard voltage between the terminals is shown under ”Specific Condition”.
Use the illustration above as a reference for the ECM terminals.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specific Condition
BATT (E5-3) - E1 (E7-1)
BR - BR
Battery (for measuring
battery voltage and for
ECM memory)
Always
9 to 14 V
+BM (E6-6) - E1 (E7-1)
W - BR
Power source of throttle
motor
Always
9 to 14 V
IGSW (E5-9) - E1 (E7-1)
P - BR
Ignition switch
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
+B (E5-1) - E1 (E7-1)
W - BR
Power source of ECM
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
+B2 (E5-2) - E1 (E7-1)
W - BR
Power source of ECM
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
OC1+ (E9-16) - OC1- (E9-15)
G-W - G-R
Camshaft timing (OCV)
Ignition switch ON
Pulse generation
(See page 05-448 )
OC2+ (E9-14) - OC2- (E9-13)
L-R - G-B
Camshaft timing (OCV)
Ignition switch ON
Pulse generation
(See page 05-448 )
B - BR
EFI relay
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
Y - BR
Power source of sensor
(specific voltage)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
MREL (E5-8) - E1 (E7-1)
VC (E7-18) - E2 (E7-28)
VG (E7-30) - E2G (E7-29)
R - L-W
Mass air flow meter
Idling, shift lever position P or N,
A/C switch OFF
0.5 to 3.0 V
THA (E7-20) - E2 (E7-28)
L-B - BR
Intake air temperature
sensor
Idling, intake air temp. 20°C (68°F)
0.5 to 3.4 V
THW (E7-19) - E2 (E7-28)
G-B - BR
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Idling, engine coolant temp. 80°C
(176°F)
0.2 to 1.0 V
VTA1 (E7-21) - E2 (E7-28)
R-W - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, throttle valve fully closed
0.5 to 1.2 V
VTA1 (E7-21) - E2 (E7-28)
R-W - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, throttle valve fully open
3.2 to 4.8 V
VTA2 (E7-31) - E2 (E7-28)
B-R - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for sensor malfunction
detection)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal released
2.1 to 3.1 V
VTA2 (E7-31) - E2 (E7-28)
B-R - BR
Throttle position sensor
(for sensor malfunction
detection)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal depressed
4.5 to 5.5 V
VPA (E5-22) - EPA (E5-28)
B-R
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal released
0.5 to 1.1 V
VPA (E5-22) - EPA (E5-28)
B-R
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for engine control)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal depressed
2.6 to 4.5 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
584
05-395
DIAGNOSTICS
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specific Condition
VPA2 (E5-23) - EPA2 (E5-29)
W - BR
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for sensor malfunction detection)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal released
1.2 to 2.0 V
VPA2 (E5-23) - EPA2 (E5-29)
W - BR
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for sensor malfunction detection)
Ignition switch ON, accelerator pedal depressed
3.4 to 5.3 V
VCPA (E5-26) - EPA (E5-28)
G-R
Power source of accelerator pedal position sensor
(for VPA)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
VCP2 (E5-27) - EPA2 (E5-29)
L - BR
Power source of accelerator pedal position sensor
(for VPA2)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
Below 3.0 V
HA1H (E8-5) - E04 (E8-7)
HA2A (E8-4) - E05 (E8-6)
B-W - W-B
R-W - W-B
A/F sensor heater
Idling
HA1H (E8-5) - E04 (E8-7)
HA2A (E8-4) - E05 (E8-6)
B-W - W-B
R-W - W-B
A/F sensor heater
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
A1A+ (E8-22) - E1 (E7-1)
BR - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.0 to 3.6 V
A2A+ (E8-23) - E1 (E7-1)
P - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
3.0 to 3.6 V
A1A- (E8-30) - E1 (E7-1)
Y - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
2.7 to 3.3 V
A2A- (E8-31) - E1 (E7-1)
L - BR
A/F sensor
Ignition switch ON
2.7 to 3.3 V
Below 3.0 V
HT1B (E8-25) - E2 (E7-28)
HT2B (E8-33) - E2 (E7-28)
R-Y - BR
W-L - BR
Heated oxygen sensor
heater
Idling
HT1B (E8-25) - E2 (E7-28)
HT2B (E8-33) - E2 (E7-28)
R-Y - BR
W-L - BR
Heated oxygen sensor
heater
Ignition switch ON
OX1B (E8-21) - E2 (E7-28)
OX2B (E8-29) - E2 (E7-28)
W - BR
B - BR
Heated oxygen sensor
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm
for 2 minutes after warming up
9 to 14 V
Pulse generation
#10
#20
#30
#40
#50
#60
(E7-1)
(E7-2)
(E7-3)
(E7-4)
(E7-5)
(E8-3)
-
E01
E01
E01
E01
E01
E01
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
L - W-B
Y - W-B
B - W-B
W - W-B
B-W - W-B
G - W-B
Injector
Ignition switch ON
#10
#20
#30
#40
#50
#60
(E7-1)
(E7-2)
(E7-3)
(E7-4)
(E7-5)
(E8-3)
-
E01
E01
E01
E01
E01
E01
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
(E7-7)
L - W-B
Y - W-B
B - W-B
W - W-B
B-W - W-B
G - W-B
Injector
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page 05-511)
9 to 14 V
KNK1 (E8-1) - EKNK (E8-28)
B -W
Knock sensor
Maintain engine speed at 4,000 rpm
after warming up
Pulse generation
(See page 05-527 )
KNK2 (E8-2) - EKN2 (E8-20)
R -G
Knock sensor
Maintain engine speed at 4,000 rpm
after warming up
Pulse generation
(See page 05-527 )
VV1+ (E9-27) - NE- (E9-24)
B-W - G
VVT sensor
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page 05-532 )
VV2+ (E9-26) - NE- (E9-24)
L -G
VVT sensor
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page 05-532 )
NE+ (E9-25) - NE- (E9-24)
R -G
Crankshaft position sensor
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page 05-532 )
Ignition coil with igniter
(ignition signal)
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page 05-541 )
IGT1
IGT2
IGT3
IGT4
IGT5
IGT6
(E7-8) - E1 (E7-1)
(E7-9) - E1 (E7-1)
(E7-10) - E1 (E7-1)
(E7-11) - E1 (E7-1)
(E7-12) - E1 (E7-1)
(E7-13) - E1 (E7-1)
R-L - BR
P - BR
Y-B - BR
L-Y - BR
G-Y - BR
L-R - BR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
585
05-396
DIAGNOSTICS
Symbols (Terminal No.)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
IGF1 (E7-24) - E1 (E7-1)
W-R - BR
Ignition coil with igniter
(ignition confirmation signal)
Ignition switch ON
IGF1 (E7-24) - E1 (E7-1)
W-R - BR
Ignition coil with igniter
(ignition confirmation signal)
Idling
PRG (E7-34) - E1 (E7-1)
G - BR
EVAP VSV
Ignition switch ON
CCV (E7-27) - E1 (E7-1)
L - BR
CCV
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
PTNK (E5-21) - E1 (E7-1)
L - BR
Vapor pressure sensor
Ignition switch ON
2.9 to 3.7 V
PTNK (E5-21) - E1 (E7-1)
L - BR
Vapor pressure sensor
Ignition switch ON, apply vacuum
4.0 kPa (30 mmHg, 1.18 in.Hg)
Below 0.5 V
SPD (E6-17) - E1 (E7-1)
Y - BR
Speed signal from combination meter
Ignition switch ON, rotate driving
wheel slowly
Pulse generation
(See page 05-578 )
STA (E7-17) - E1 (E7-1)
B - BR
Starter signal
Cranking
STP (E6-19) - E1 (E7-1)
BR - BR
Stop lamp switch
Ignition switch ON, brake pedal is
depressed
7.5 to 14 V
STP (E6-19) - E1 (E7-1)
BR - BR
Stop lamp switch
Ignition switch ON, brake pedal is
released
Below 1.5 V
ST1- (E6-12) - E1 (E7-1)
V - BR
Stop lamp switch
(opposite to stop)
Ignition switch ON, brake pedal is
depressed
Below 1.5 V
ST1- (E6-12) - E1 (E7-1)
V - BR
Stop lamp switch
(opposite to stop)
Ignition switch ON, brake pedal is
released
7.5 to 14 V
NSW (E7-16) - E1 (E7-1)
B-R - BR
PNP switch
Ignition switch ON, shift lever position in P or N
Below 3.0 V
NSW (E7-16) - E1 (E7-1)
B-R - BR
PNP switch
Ignition switch ON, except shift lever position in P or N
9 to 14 V
M+ (E9-3) - ME01 (E9-4)
M- (E9-2) - ME01 (E9-4)
B - W-B
W - W-B
Throttle motor
Idling
Y - BR
Fuel pump control
Ignition switch ON
FC (E5-10) - E1 (E7-1)
Y - BR
Fuel pump control
Idling
W (E5-11) - E1 (E7-1)
SB - BR
MIL
Ignition switch ON
W (E5-11) - E1 (E7-1)
SB - BR
MIL
Idling
9 to 14 V
ELS2 (E5-12) - E1 (E7-1)
G - BR
Electric load
Power outlet OFF
0 to 1.5 V
ELS2 (E5-12) - E1 (E7-1)
G - BR
Electric load
Power outlet ON
7.5 to 14 V
TC (E5-20) - E1 (E7-1)
O - BR
Terminal TC of DLC 3
Ignition switch ON
SIL (E5-18) - E1 (E7-1)
R - BR
Terminal SIL of DLC3
During transmission
Pulse generation
TACH (E5-5) - E1 (E7-1)
B - BR
Engine speed
Idling
Pulse generation
ACIS (E7-15) - E1 (E7-1)
R-Y - BR
VSV for ACIS
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
ACM (E9-6) - E1 (E7-1)
Y-G - BR
VSV for ACM
Ignition switch ON
9 to 14 V
V-R
Electric load (from skid
control ECU)
Idling
Pulse generation
Y-G
Electric load (from skid
control ECU)
Idling
Pulse generation
PS pressure switch
Ignition switch ON
FC (E5-10) - E1 (E7-1)
ENG+ (E5-24) ENG- (E5-30)
TRC+ (E5-25) - TRC- (E5-31)
PSW (E9-10) - E1 (E9-1)
R-W - BR
Condition
Specific Condition
4.5 to 5.5 V
Pulse generation
(See page 05-541 )
9 to 14 V
6 V or higher
Pulse generation
9 to 14 V
0 to 3 V
Below 3.0 V
9 to 14 V
9 to 14 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
586
10-2
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
100IO-05
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
Air
E2
VG
+B
THA E2G
5 4 3 2 1
(b)
30
20
Resistance kΩ
10
INSPECT MASS AIR FLOW METER
Check the output voltage.
(1) Apply battery voltage across terminals 1 (+B) and 2
(E2G).
(2) Connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal 3
(VG), and negative (-) tester probe to terminal 2
(E2G).
(3) Blow air into the Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter, and
check that the voltage fluctuates.
Measure the resistance between terminals 4 (THA) and
5 (E2).
Standard:
Condition
Specified Condition
5
-20 C (-4F)
13.6 to 18.4 kΩ
3
2
20C (68F)
2.21 to 2.69 kΩ
60C (140F)
0.493 to 0.667 kΩ
1
If the result is not as specified, replace the MAF meter.
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
-20
0 20 40 60 80 100
(-4) (32) (68) (104)(140) (176) (212)
Temperature C (F)
A93068
2.
1
2
Valve
A50377
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSY
(a) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard: 6.9 to 7.9 Ω at 20C (68F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the OCV assy.
(b) Connect the battery’s positive (+) lead to terminal 1 and
negative (-) lead to terminal 2, and check the movement
of the valve.
NOTICE:
Confirm that the valve moves freely and does not become
stuck in any position.
If necessary, replace the OCV assy.
HINT:
If the valve cannot return properly because of foreign matter, a
small pressure leak in the advanced direction may occur and a
DTC will be output.
Author:
Date:
2360
10-3
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY
Check the accelerator pedal position sensor (see page 05-102 ).
4.
(a)
(b)
6
5
VTA VC
4
VTA2
3
E2
2
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY ASSY
Check the throttle position sensor (see page 05-469 ).
Check the throttle control motor.
(1) Measure the resistance between terminals 2 (M+)
and 1 (M-).
Resistance: 0.3 to 100 Ω at 20C (68F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the throttle body assy.
1
M+
MA75258
5.
(a)
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
Measure the resistance between terminals 1 and 2.
Standard:
Condition
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ
80C (176F)
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
NOTICE:
If checking the ECT sensor in the water, keep the terminals
dry. After the check, wipe the sensor dry.
30
20
Resistance kΩ
3.
(a)
-
10
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
-20 0 20 40 60 80 100
(-4) (32) (68)(104) (140) (176) (212)
TemperatureC (F)
A91320
6.
(a)
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR
Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard: 120 to 280 kΩ at 20C (68F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
A65174
Author:
Date:
2361
10-4
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
1
1
2
2
5
5
3
3
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT RELAY (Marking: EFI, A/F)
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Remove the A/F relay from the engine room R/B No. 2.
Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
A93067
1
1
2
2
5
5
3
3
A93067
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
8.
INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
(a) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B sub-assy
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
Author:
Date:
2362
10-1
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
SFI SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
10068-07
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
CHECK THROTTLE BODY
Listen to the throttle control motor operating sounds.
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) When pressing the accelerator pedal position sensor lever, listen to the running motor. Make sure
no friction noise comes from the motor.
If friction noise exists, replace the throttle body.
(b) Check the throttle position sensor.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Check that the check engine warning light does not light up.
(4) Under CURRENT DATA, the throttle valve opening percentage (THROTTLE POS) should be
within the standard value range below.
Standard throttle valve opening percentage: 60 % or more
If the percentage is less than 60 %, replace the throttle position sensor.
NOTICE:
When checking the standard throttle valve opening percentage, the transmission should be in the
neutral position.
2.
CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON. Under CURRENT DATA, the voltage of the throttle position sensor should
be within the standard value range below.
Standard: 0.6 to 1.0 V
If the result is not as specified, replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
3.
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE (OCV) ASSY
(a) Connect the hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Start the engine and warm it up.
(d) Select the VVT from the ACTIVE TEST menu.
(e) Check the engine speed when the OCV is operated by the hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool.
Standard:
Condition
Specified Condition
VVT system is OFF (OCV is OFF)
Normal engine speed
VVT system is ON (OCV is ON)
Rough idle or engine stalled
If the result is not as specified, replace the OCV assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2359
10-5
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
THROTTLE BODY ASSY (2AZ-FE)
THROTTLE BODY ASSY (2AZ-FE)
1006A-07
COMPONENTS
Fuel Vapor Feed Hose
MAF Meter Connector
VSV Connector for EVAP
Air Cleaner Cap
Sub-assy
30 (305, 22)
Fuel Pipe Support
30 (305, 22)
Throttle Body Assy
Water By-pass Hose
No, 1
Water By-pass Hose No. 2
Gasket
Throttle Control Motor & Throttle
Position Sensor Connector
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A93431
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2363
10-6
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
THROTTLE BODY ASSY (2AZ-FE)
1006B-05
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP WITH AIR CLEANER HOSE (See page 14-24 )
3.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY ASSY
(a) Disconnect the throttle control motor & throttle position
sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throttle body.
(c) Disconnect the 2 water by-pass hoses.
(d)
(e)
Remove the 4 bolts, fuel pipe support and throttle body.
Remove the gasket.
4.
(a)
INSTALL THROTTLE BODY ASSY
Install a new gasket to the intake manifold, as shown in
the illustration.
(b)
Install the throttle body and fuel pipe support with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 30 N⋅m (305 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the 2 water by-pass hoses to the throttle body.
Connect the throttle control motor & throttle position sensor connector.
Connect the vacuum hose to the throttle body.
A60798
B09649
(c)
(d)
(e)
A60798
5.
6.
7.
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP WITH AIR CLEANER HOSE (See page 14-24 )
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-1 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2364
10-7
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
KNOCK SENSOR (2AZ-FE)
KNOCK SENSOR (2AZ-FE)
100IP-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP WITH AIR CLEANER HOSE (See page 14-24 )
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY ASSY (See page 10-6 )
4.
(a)
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD
Remove the 5 bolts, 2 nuts, intake manifold and gasket.
5.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR
Disconnect the sensor connector.
Remove the nut and sensor.
A61987
A92776
6.
(a)
Upper
10
Engine
Front
10
INSTALL KNOCK SENSOR
Install the sensor with the nut.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (199 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:Angling the knock sensor below the horizontal (below 0)
is recommended.
(b) Connect the sensor connector.
A78436
7.
(a)
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
Install a new gasket and the intake manifold with the 5
bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 30 N⋅m (305 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
A61987
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2365
10-8
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
8.
9.
10.
11.
-
KNOCK SENSOR (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL THROTTLE BODY ASSY (See page 10-6 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP WITH AIR CLEANER HOSE (See page 14-24 )
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-1 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2366
10-9
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
ECM (2AZ-FE)
ECM (2AZ-FE)
100IQ-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page 71-10 )
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM SUB-ASSY RH (See page 71-10 )
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSY (See page 71-10 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER NO.2 (See page 71-10 )
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE ECM
Remove the 2 wire harness clamps.
Disconnect the 5 ECM connectors.
Remove the 2 nuts and ECM.
7.
(a)
REMOVE ECM BRACKET NO. 1
Remove the 2 screws and ECM bracket.
8.
(a)
9.
(a)
REMOVE ECM BRACKET NO. 2
Remove the 2 screws and ECM bracket.
INSTALL ECM BRACKET NO. 2
Install the ECM bracket with the 2 screws.
10.
(a)
INSTALL ECM BRACKET NO. 1
Install the ECM bracket with the 2 screws.
I30545
A90275
A90283
A90275
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2367
10-10
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
11.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
ECM (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL ECM
Install the 2 wire harness clamps.
Connect the 5 ECM connectors.
Install the ECM with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
I30545
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER NO.2 (See page 71-10 )
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSY (See page 71-10 )
INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM SUB-ASSY RH (See page 71-10 )
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page 71-10 )
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2368
10-13
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
100FT-04
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
Air
E2
VG
+B
THA E2G
5 4 3 2 1
(b)
30
20
Resistance kΩ
10
INSPECT MASS AIR FLOW METER
Check the output voltage.
(1) Apply battery voltage across terminals 1 (+B) and 2
(E2G).
(2) Connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal
VG, and negative (-) tester probe to terminal E2G.
(3) Blow air into the Mass Air Flow (MAF) meter, and
check that the voltage fluctuates.
Measure the resistance between terminals 4 (THA) and
5 (E2).
Standard:
Condition
Specified Condition
-20 C (-4F)
13.6 to 18.4 kΩ
5
20C (68F)
2.21 to 2.69 kΩ
3
2
60C (140F)
0.493 to 0.667 kΩ
If the result is not as specified, replace the MAF meter.
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
-20
0 20 40 60 80 100
(-4) (32) (68) (104)(140) (176) (212)
Temperature C (F)
A93068
2.
1
2
Valve
A50377
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSY
(a) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard: 6.9 to 7.9 Ω at 20C (68F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the OCV assy.
(b) Connect the battery’s positive (+) lead to terminal 1 and
negative (-) lead to terminal 2, and check the movement
of the valve.
NOTICE:
Confirm that the valve moves freely and does not become
stuck in any position.
If necessary, replace the OCV assy.
HINT:
If the valve cannot return properly because of foreign matter, a
small pressure leak in the advanced direction may occur and a
DTC will be output.
Author:
Date:
2371
10-14
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY
Check the acceletor pedal position sensor (see page 05-469 ).
4.
(a)
(b)
6
5
VTA VC
4
VTA2
3
E2
2
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY ASSY
Check the throttle position sensor (see page 05-469 ).
Check the throttle control motor.
(1) Measure the resistance between terminals 2 (M+)
and 1 (M-).
Resistance: 0.3 to 100 Ω at 20C (68F).
If the result is not as specified, replace the throttle body assy.
1
M+
MA75258
5.
(a)
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
Measure the resistance between each terminal.
Standard:
Condition
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ
80C (176F)
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
NOTICE:
If checking the ECT sensor in the water, keep the terminals
dry. After the check, wipe the sensor dry.
30
20
Resistance kΩ
3.
(a)
-
10
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
-20 0 20 40 60 80 100
(-4) (32) (68)(104) (140) (176) (212)
TemperatureC (F)
A91320
6.
(a)
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR
Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: 120 to 280 kΩ at 20C (68F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
A65174
Author:
Date:
2372
10-15
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
1
1
2
2
5
5
3
3
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT RELAY (Marking: EFI, A/F)
Remove the EFI relay from the engine room J/B.
Remove the A/F relay from the engine room R/B No. 2.
Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
A93067
1
1
2
2
5
5
3
3
A93067
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
8.
INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
(a) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B sub-assy.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
Author:
Date:
2373
10-12
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
SFI SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
100FS-06
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
CHECK THROTTLE BODY
Listen to the throttle control motor operating sounds.
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) When pressing the accelerator pedal position sensor lever, listen to the running motor. Make sure
no friction noise comes from the motor.
If friction noise exists, replace the throttle body.
(b) Inspect the throttle position sensor.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Check that the MIL is off.
(4) Under CURRENT DATA, the throttle valve opening percentage (THROTTLE POS) should be
within the standard value range below.
Standard throttle valve opening percentage: 60 % or more
If the percentage is less than 60 %, replace the throttle position sensor.
NOTICE:
When checking the standard throttle valve opening percentage, the transmission should be in the
neutral position.
2.
CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON. Under CURRENT DATA, the voltage of the throttle position sensor should
be within the standard value range below.
Standard: 0.6 to 1.0 V
If the result is not as specified, replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
3.
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE (OCV) ASSY
(a) Connect the hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Start the engine and warm it up.
(d) Select the VVT from the ACTIVE TEST menu.
(e) Check the engine speed when the OCV is operated by the hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool.
Standard:
Condition
Specified Condition
VVT system is OFF (OCV is OFF)
Normal engine speed
VVT system is ON (OCV is ON)
Rough idle or engine stalled
If the result is not as specified, replace the OCV assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2370
10-16
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
THROTTLE BODY ASSY (3MZ-FE)
THROTTLE BODY ASSY (3MZ-FE)
100IU-03
COMPONENTS
80 (815, 59)
x2
Spacer
w/ Performance Rod:
Front Suspension Upper Brace Center
7.9 (81, 70 in.⋅lbf)
80 (815, 59)
x3
x2
V-Bank Cover Sub-assy
Spacer
Fuel Vapor Feed Hose Assy
Vacuum Hose
MAF Meter
Connector
Vacuum Hose
Air Cleaner Cap Sub-assy
Air Cleaner Filter Element
Sub-assy
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A93427
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2374
10-17
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
THROTTLE BODY ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Gasket
Throttle Body Assy
Throttle Control Motor &
Throttle Position Sensor
Connector
Water By-pass Hose No. 2
11 (112, 8)
Water By-pass Hose No. 3
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A82430
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2375
10-18
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
THROTTLE BODY ASSY (3MZ-FE)
100IV-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
(a)
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
Remove the 2 nuts and upper brace.
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY
Using a socket hexagon wrench 5, remove the 3 nuts.
Remove the V-bank cover.
A88625
4.
5.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER INLET ASSY (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSY (See page 14-149 )
(b)
(b)
(c)
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE INTAKE AIR RESONATOR
Remove the ventilation hose No. 2.
Remove the fuel vapor feed hose from the 2 hose clamps.
Loosen the air cleaner hose clamp bolt, and then remove
the intake air resonator.
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY ASSY
Disconnect the throttle control motor & throttle position
sensor connector.
Disconnect the water by-pass hose No. 2.
Disconnect the water by-pass hose No. 3.
(d)
(e)
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and throttle body.
Remove the gasket.
(a)
A81196
(a)
(b)
(c)
A81197
A81198
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2376
10-19
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
8.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
(a)
(b)
16.
(a)
-
THROTTLE BODY ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL THROTTLE BODY ASSY
Install a new gasket to the intake air connector.
Install the throttle body with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 11 N⋅m (112 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the water by-pass hose No. 3.
Connect the water by-pass hose No. 2.
Connect the throttle control motor & throttle position sensor connector.
INSTALL INTAKE AIR RESONATOR
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSY (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER INLET ASSY (See page 14-149 )
CHECK CONNECTION OF VACUUM HOSE (See page 14-149 )
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-20 )
INSTALL V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY
Fit the 2 retainers and install the V-bank cover.
Using a socket hexagon wrench 5, tighten the 3 nuts.
Torque: 7.9 N⋅m (81 kgf⋅cm, 70 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
Install the upper brace with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 80 N⋅m (815 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2377
10-20
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
KNOCK SENSOR (3MZ-FE)
KNOCK SENSOR (3MZ-FE)
100FX-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page 11-35 )
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
REMOVE V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK (See page 14-149 )
7.
(a)
Pull
Pinch
Pinch
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD
Disconnect the fuel pipe No. 1.
(1) Remove the fuel pipe clamp.
(2) Pinch the tube connector and pull out the fuel pipe
No. 1.
Fuel Pipe Clamp
A81199
Nylon Tube
Tube Connector
O-ring
Pipe
A75650
NOTICE:
Check the connector for dirt, mud or other contamination. Clean if necessary.
Be sure to keep the tube connector, pipe and O-ring
clean. They can become contaminated easily.
Do not use tools when disconnecting the fuel pipe.
Do not bend or twist the nylon tube. Protect the connector by covering it with a vinyl or plastic bag.
When the pipe and the connector are stuck, push and
pull the connector to release it. Then pull the connector out carefully.
(b)
(c)
Lock the hose clamp, as shown in the illustration.
Disconnect the heater inlet water hose.
(c)
(b)
A79759
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2378
10-21
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
(e)
(d)
(d)
(e)
(e)
(e)
(e)
-
KNOCK SENSOR (3MZ-FE)
Remove the nut and disconnect the ground cable.
Disconnect the 6 fuel injector connectors.
(e)
(e)
A81200
(f)
Loosen and remove the intake manifold’s 9 bolts and 2
nuts little by little in the numerical order shown in the illustration.
(g) Remove the intake manifold.
NOTICE:
Fully removing each bolt and nut one by one may damage
the intake manifold, bolts and nuts.
10
4
2
6
8
3
11
5
9
7
1
A81201
8.
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
9.
(a)
(a)
REMOVE WATER OUTLET
Disconnect the radiator hose inlet.
A81202
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2379
10-22
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(e)
(b)
-
KNOCK SENSOR (3MZ-FE)
(f)
Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
Remove the clamp.
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and 2 washers.
Lock the hose clamp as shown in the illustration. Then remove the water outlet together with the water by-pass
hose No. 1.
Remove the 2 gaskets from the 2 cylinder heads.
10.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR
Disconnect the 2 sensor connectors.
Remove the 2 nuts and 2 sensors.
11.
(a)
INSTALL KNOCK SENSOR
Install the 2 sensors with the 2 nuts, as shown in the illustration.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (199 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the 2 sensor connectors.
(c)
A81203
A79749
Upper
0 to 5
(b)
Engine
Front
A79750
12.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
13.
INSTALL WATER OUTLET
Install 2 new gaskets to the 2 cylinder heads.
Install the water outlet together with the water by-pass hose No. 1 and unlock the hose clamp.
Tighten the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and 2 washers.
Torque: 15 N⋅m (153 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
Install the clamp.
Connect the ECT sensor connector.
Connect the radiator hose inlet.
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2380
10-23
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
KNOCK SENSOR (3MZ-FE)
14.
(a)
2
8
10
6
4
9
1
5
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
Tighten the intake manifolds’s 9 bolts and 2 nuts little by
little in the numerical order shown in the illustration.
Torque: 15 N⋅m (153 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
In this case, fully tightening one of these bolts or nuts without partially tightening the other bolts or nuts in the group
may damage the intake manifold, bolts and nuts.
(b) Retighten the water outlet mounting bolts and nuts.
Torque: 15 N⋅m (153 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
(c) Install the ground cable with the nut.
Torque: 8.4 N⋅m (86 kgf⋅cm, 74 in.⋅lbf)
(d) Connect the heater inlet water hose.
7
3
11
A81201
(e)
Push
A81204
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
Connect the fuel pipe No. 1.
(1) Push the quick connector into the pipe until it makes
”click” sound.
NOTICE:
Check if there is any damage or contamination on the
connected part.
After connecting, confirm that the connector and pipe
are securely connected by trying to pull them apart.
(2) Install the fuel pipe clamp.
INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
CHECK CONNECTION OF VACUUM HOSE (See page 14-149 )
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-20 )
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS
INSTALL V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2381
10-24
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
ECM (3MZ-FE)
ECM (3MZ-FE)
100IW-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page 71-10 )
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM SUB-ASSY RH (See page 71-10 )
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSY (See page 71-10 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER NO.2 (See page 71-10 )
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE ECM
Remove the 2 wire harness clamps.
Disconnect the 5 ECM connectors.
Remove the 2 nuts and ECM.
7.
(a)
REMOVE ECM BRACKET NO. 1
Remove the 2 screws and ECM bracket.
8.
(a)
9.
(a)
REMOVE ECM BRACKET NO. 2
Remove the 2 screws and ECM bracket.
INSTALL ECM BRACKET NO. 2
Install the ECM bracket with the 2 screws.
10.
(a)
INSTALL ECM BRACKET NO. 1
Install the ECM bracket with the 2 screws.
I30545
A90275
A90283
A90275
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2382
10-25
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
11.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
ECM (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL ECM
Install the 2 wire harness clamps.
Connect the 5 ECM connectors.
Install the ECM with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
I30545
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER NO.2 (See page 71-10 )
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSY (See page 71-10 )
INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM SUB-ASSY RH (See page 71-10 )
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page 71-10 )
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2383
10-26
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
100MJ-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY
Disconnect the accelerator pedal position sensor connector.
Remove the 2 bolts and pedal rod.
INSTALL ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY
Install the pedal rod with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 4.9 N⋅m (50 kgf⋅cm, 43 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the accelerator pedal position sensor connector.
A81214
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2384
10-1 1
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
100MI-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY
Disconnect the accelerator pedal position sensor connector.
Remove the 2 bolts and pedal rod.
INSTALL ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD ASSY
Install the pedal rod with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 4.9 N⋅m (50 kgf⋅cm, 43 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the acceleator pedal position sensor connector.
A81214
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2369
11-7
FUEL
-
FUEL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
11024-07
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
Check the injector resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard: 11.6 to 12.4 Ω at 20C (68F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the injector.
(b) Check the injector injection.
CAUTION:
This test involves high-pressure fuel and electricity.
Take every precaution regarding safe handling of
both the fuel and the electricity.
Perform this test in a safe area, and avoid any sparks
or flame.
Do not smoke.
(1)
Fuel Tube Connector
Purchase a new fuel tube and disconnect the fuel
tube connector from its pipe.
Fuel tube: Part No. 23801-20180
A50710
(2)
Connect SST and fuel tube connector to the fuel
pipe.
SST 09268-41047
CAUTION:
Always read the precautions (see page 11-1 ) before connecting the fuel tube connector (quick type).
Fuel Tube Connector
SST
(Hose)
B12947
(3)
(4)
Install the O-ring to the injector.
Connect SST (union and hose) to the injector, and
hold the injector and union with SST (clamp).
SST 09268-41047 (09268-41110, 09268-41300)
(5) Put the injector into a graduated cylinder.
SST (Hose)
SST (Union)
O-Ring
SST
(Clamp)
Vinyl Tube
A51875
HINT:
Install a suitable vinyl tube onto the injector to contain the gasoline spray.
(6) Operate the fuel pump (see page 11-4 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2391
11-8
FUEL
-
FUEL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
(7)
(8)
Connect SST to the connector of injector.
Connect SST (wire) to the battery for 15 seconds,
and measure the injection volume with a graduated
cylinder. Test each injector 2 or 3 time.
SST 09842-30080
Standard:
SST
Item
Specified Condition
Injection Volume
76 to 92 cm3 (4.6 to 5.6 cu in.)
per 15 seconds
Difference Between Each Injector
16 cm3 (1.0 cu in.) or less
A50700
NOTICE:
Always turn on and off the voltage on the battery side, not
the fuel pump side.
If the injection volume is not as specified, replace the injector.
(c)
Check fuel leakage.
(1) In the condition above, disconnect the test probes
of SST (wire) from the battery and check the fuel
leakage from the injector.
Fuel drop: 1 drop or less per 12 minutes
B00069
2.
(a)
(-)
A16628
(+)
A91308
INSPECT FUEL PUMP ASSY
Check fuel pump resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: 0.2 to 3.0 Ω at 20C (68F)
(b) Check fuel pump operation.
(1) Apply battery voltage to both terminals. Check that
the pump operates.
NOTICE:
These tests must be done within 10 seconds to prevent the coil from burning out.
Keep the fuel pump as far away from the battery as
possible.
Always turn on and off the voltage on the battery side,
not the fuel pump side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2392
11-4
FUEL
-
FUEL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
CHECK FUEL PUMP OPERATION AND FUEL LEAKS
When using the hand-held tester:
Check fuel pump operation.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held
tester main switch ON.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(3) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the hand-held
tester.
(4) Please refer to the hand-held tester’s instruction
manual for further details.
(5) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(6) Disconnect the hand-held tester from the DLC3.
11023-07
(b)
R/B Sub-assy
FP
+B
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
Circuit Opening
Relay
A92782
When not using the hand-held tester:
Check fuel pump operation.
(1) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(2) Using a service wire, connect terminals FP and +B
of the R/B sub-assy.
NOTICE:
Pay close attention to the terminal connecting position to
avoid a malfunction.
(3) Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the fuel
pump operates.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(c) Check that there are no fuel leaks after doing maintenance anywhere on the fuel system.
(d) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(e) Remove the servive wire from the R/B sub-assy.
(f)
Install the circuit opening relay to the R/B sub-assy.
2.
(a)
(b)
Fuel Tube Connector
(c)
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
Check that the battery positive voltage is above 12 V.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
Purchase a new fuel tube and take out the fuel tube connector from its pipe.
Fuel tube: Part No. 23801-20180
A50710
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2388
11-5
FUEL
(d)
Fuel Pipe
Clamp No. 1
-
FUEL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Remove the fuel pipe clamp No. 1 from the fuel tube connector.
A60083
(e)
Disconnect the fuel tube connector from the fuel pipe by
pinching part A with fingers, as shown in the illustration.
CAUTION:
Always read the precautions (see page 11-1 ) before
disconnecting the fuel tube connector (quick type).
The fuel pipe line may spray fuel as a result of retained pressure that remains in it. Do not allow fuel to
be sprayed in the engine compartment.
A
A
B12941
(f)
SST
(Clip)
SST
SST (T-Joint)
Fuel Tube
SST
(Hose)
Fuel Tube Connector
A93071
Install SST (pressure gauge) and fuel tube connecter using SST as shown in the illustration.
SST 09268-41047, 09268-45014 (09268-41250)
(g) Wipe up any gasoline.
(h) Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
(i)
When using the hand-held tester:
Operate the fuel pump (see step 1 (a)).
(j)
When not using the hand-held tester:
Operate the fuel pump (see step 1 (b)).
(k) Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure:
304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 50 psi)
If the pressure is high, replace the fuel pressure regulator.
If the pressure is low, check the fuel hoses and connections,
fuel pump, fuel filter and fuel pressure regulator.
(l)
Start the engine.
(m) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure:
304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 50 psi)
(n) Stop the engine.
(o) Check that the fuel pressure remains as specified for 5
minutes after the engine has stopped.
Fuel pressure: 147 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm2, 21 psi)
If the pressure is not as specified, check the fuel pump, pressure regulator and/or injectors.
(p) After checking the fuel pressure, disconnect the negative
(-) battery cable and carefully remove SST and fuel tube
connector to prevent gasoline from spraying.
(q) Reconnect the fuel inlet tube (fuel tube connector).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2389
11-6
FUEL
-
FUEL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CAUTION:
Always read the precautions (see page 11-1 ) before connecting the fuel tube connector (quick type).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2390
11-1
FUEL
-
FUEL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
FUEL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
110XE-03
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Before working on the fuel system, disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
Do not smoke or be near an open flame when working on the fuel system.
Keep gasoline away from rubber or leather parts.
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
CAUTION:
Do not disconnect any part of the fuel system until
you have discharged the fuel system pressure.
Even after discharging the fuel pressure, place a
shop rag over fittings as you separate them to reduce
risk of fuel spray on yourself or in the engine compartment.
(a)
(b)
R/B Sub-assy
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
Circuit Opening
Relay
A93007
Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B sub-assy.
Start the engine. After the engine has stopped, turn the
ignition switch OFF.
HINT:
There is a case that DTC P0171 (system to lean) is output.
(c) Check that the engine does not start.
(d) Remove the fuel tank cap, and let the air out of the fuel
tank.
(e) Reinstall the circuit opening relay.
2.
(a)
FUEL SYSTEM
When disconnecting the high fuel pressure line, a large
amount of gasoline will spill out, so observe these procedures.
(1) Perform step 2 to prevent gasoline from spilling out.
(2) Put a container under the connection.
(3) Disconnect the fuel pump tube (see page 11-16 ).
(4) Drain the fuel remained inside the fuel pump tube.
(5)
To protect the disconnected fuel pump tube from
damage and contamination, cover it with a vinyl
bag.
B00679
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2385
11-2
FUEL
New O-Ring
CORRECT
-
FUEL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
(b)
Observe these precautions when removing and installing
the injector.
(1) Never reuse O-rings.
(2) When placing a new O-ring on the injector, take
care not to damage it.
(3) Coat a new O-rings with grease or gasoline before
installing. Never use engine, gear or brake oil.
(c)
Install the injector to the delivery pipe and cylinder head,
as shown in the illustration. Before installing the injector,
be sure to apply grease or gasoline on the place where
the delivery pipe touches the O-ring of the injector.
(d)
Observe these precautions when disconnecting the fuel
delivery pipe.
Grommet Delivery Pipe
Injector
INCORRECT
A94329
Delivery Pipe
O-Ring
Grommet
A94330
O-ring
Retainer Pipe
HINT:
The structure of the metallic connector is shown as left.
(1) Remove the fuel pipe clamp No. 2.
Nylon Tube
Housing
A50709
(2)
Find the metallic connector of the fuel tube assembly, pull it out towards the rear and hold it as it is.
(3) Assemble SST to the connection as shown.
SST 09268-21010
SST
A60818
(4)
(5)
Retainer
(at 4 places)
Turn SST, align the retainers inside the connector
with SST chamfered parts and insert SST into the
connector.
Slide SST and the connector together towards the
fuel tube assembly.
B09615
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2386
11-3
FUEL
(e)
Fuel Pipe
Clamp No.1
-
FUEL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Observe these following precautions when disconnecting
the fuel tube connector (quick type).
(1) Remove the fuel pipe clamp No. 1.
(2) Check for dirt or mud on the pipe and around the
connector before disconnection. Clean if nesessary.
A60083
(3)
Disconnect the connector from the hose while
pinching part A with fingers as shown in the illustration.
(4)
If the connector and the pipe are stuck, pinch the
fuel pipe, push and pull the connector to disconnect
and pull it out. Do not use any tools.
Inspect for dirt or mud on the seal surface of the disconnected pipe. Clean if necessary.
A
A
B12941
(5)
B12944
(6)
Vinyl Bag
To protect the disconnected pipe and connector
from damage and contamination, cover it with a vinyl bag.
A52581
3.
(a)
CHECK FUEL LEAK
Check that there are no fuel leaks after doing maintenance anywhere on the fuel system (see page
11-4 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2387
11-9
FUEL
-
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
1109L-05
COMPONENTS
Fuel Vapor Feed Hose
MAF Meter Connector
VSV Connector
for EVAP
Engine Wire
20 (204, 15)
Fuel Delivery Pipe
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Air Cleaner Cap
w/ Air Cleaner Hose
O-ring
Fuel Injector Assy
Insulator
Engine Cover Sub-assy No. 1
Ventilation Hose No. 2
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A93432
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2393
11-10
FUEL
-
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
11021-08
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
WORK FOR PREVENTING GASOLINE FROM SPILLING OUT (See page 11-1 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP WITH AIR CLEANER HOSE
REMOVE ENGINE COVER SUB-ASSY NO.1
DISCONNECT FUEL TUBE SUB-ASSY (See page 16-6 )
A93072
6.
(a)
5.
REMOVE FUEL DELIVERY PIPE W/INJECTOR
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the injectors when removing the delivery pipe.
(a) Remove the ventilation hose No. 2.
(b) Disconnect the 4 injector connecters from the injector.
(c) Remove the 2 clamps and wire harnesses from the delivery pipe.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts and the delivery pipe together with the
4 injectors.
(e) Remove the 2 spacers from the cylinder head.
REMOVE FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
Pull out the 4 injectors from the delivery pipe.
7.
(a)
(b)
Insulator
O-Ring
INSTALL FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
Install a new insulator to each injector.
Apply a light coat of grease or gasoline to a new O-ring
and install to each injector.
A50145
(c)
Push
Turn
Connector
B09635
Apply a light coat of grease or gasoline on the place
where a delivery pipe touches the O-ring.
(d) To install the fuel injector into the fuel delivery pipe, push
the fuel injector while twisting it back and forth.
(e) Install the 4 injectors.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to twist the O-ring.
After installing the fuel injector, check that it turns
smoothly. If not, reinstall it with a new O-ring.
(f)
Position the injector connector downward.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2394
11-1 1
FUEL
8.
(a)
(b)
Spacer
-
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL FUEL DELIVERY PIPE W/INJECTOR
Place the 2 spacers in position on the cylinder head.
Place the delivery pipe together with the 4 injectors in
position on the cylinder head.
B09636
(c)
A93072
9.
10.
11.
12.
Temporarily install the 2 bolts holding the delivery pipe to
the cylinder.
NOTICE:
After installing the fuel injector, check that it turns smoothly. If not, reinstall it with a new O-ring.
(d) Position the injector connector outward.
(e) Tighten the 2 bolts holding the delivery pipe to the cylinder
head.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
CONNECT FUEL TUBE SUB-ASSY
INSPECT FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page 11-4 )
INSTALL ENGINE COVER SUB-ASSY NO.1 (See page 14-24 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP WITH AIR CLEANER HOSE (See page 14-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2395
11-12
FUEL
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
FUEL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
1111T-01
COMPONENTS
w/ Rear No. 2 Seat
Deck Board
Rear Seat Assy RH
Seat Track Bracket
Cover Inner
Rear Seat Assy LH
Rear Seat
Track Bracket Cover Outer
x2
x4
37 (375, 27)
Seat Track Bracket
Cover Inner
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer
x4
37 (375, 27)
Rear Door Scuff Plate LH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A92780
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2396
11-13
FUEL
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
w/o Rear No. 2 Seat
Deck Board
x5
Clip
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
x 3 Clip
Rear Seat Assy RH
Rear Seat Assy LH
Rear Seat
Track Bracket Cover Outer
x2
x4
37 (375, 27)
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer
x4
x2
37 (375, 27)
Rear Door Scuff Plate LH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A92781
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2397
11-14
FUEL
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Rear Floor Service Hole Cover
Fuel Pump & Sender
Gage Connector
Fuel Pump Tube
Tube Joint Clip
Fuel Pump Gage Retainer
Fuel Suction Tube Assy w/ Pump & Gage
Fuel Suction Tube Gasket
Non-reusable part
A92785
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2398
11-15
FUEL
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Fuel Suction Plate
Sub-assy
Fuel Pump Harness
O-Ring
Fuel Pump Spacer
Clip
Fuel Pump
O-Ring
Fuel Tube Joint
No. 1
Fuel Pressure
Regulator Assy
Fuel Filter Assy
O-Ring
O-Ring
Clip
Fuel Suction Support No. 1
Fuel Sender Gage
Assy
Non-reusable part
A81632
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2399
11-16
FUEL
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
1111U-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page 11-1 )
2.
(a)
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY
Disengage the 5 clips and turn up the front side of the
deck board.
B51632
3.
4.
5.
6.
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
REMOVE REAR SEAT ASSY RH (See page 72-35 )
REMOVE REAR SEAT ASSY LH (See page 72-28 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
7.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
Remove the rear floor service hole cover.
Disconnect the fuel pump & sender gage connector.
8.
REMOVE FUEL SUCTION TUBE ASSY W/ PUMP &
GAGE
Disconnect the fuel pump tube.
(1) Remove the tube joint clip, and pull out the fuel
pump tube.
A81633
Tube Joint Clip
(a)
A81634
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2400
11-17
FUEL
Nylon Tube
Fuel Tube Joint
O-Ring
Tube Joint Clip
Fuel Suction Plate
A81635
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
NOTICE:
Before this operation, check the connector for dirt,
mud or other contamination. Clean if necessary.
Be careful of mud. The connector’s O-ring, which
seals the pipe and connector, becomes contaminated
easily.
Do not use any tool in this operation.
Do not bend or twist the nylon tube. Protect the connector by covering it with a vinyl or plastic bag.
When the pipe and connector are stuck, push and pull
the connector to release and pull the connector out
carefully.
(b)
SST
Rib
A81636
Using SST, loosen the fuel pump gage retainer.
SST 09808- 14020 (09808- 01410, 09808- 01420,
09808-01430)
NOTICE:
Loosen the retainer by turning it counterclockwise while
holding the SST down. Do not allow the claw of the tank
suction tube support to slip out of its groove on the fuel
tank.
HINT:
A rib on the fuel pump gage retainer can be fitted into a tip of
the SST.
(c) Remove the fuel pump gage retainer.
(d) Remove the fuel suction tube.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend the arm of the fuel sender gage.
(e) Remove the gasket from the fuel tank.
A80531
9.
(a)
(b)
Unlock
REMOVE FUEL SENDER GAGE ASSY
Disconnect the fuel sender gage connector.
Unlock the fuel sender gage and slide it to remove.
(a)
Slide
A79768
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2401
11-18
FUEL
REMOVE FUEL SUCTION PLATE SUB-ASSY
Using a screwdriver with the tip wrapped in tape, disconnect the 4 snap-claws from the claw holes and remove
the fuel suction plate.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fuel suction plate and fuel suction support No. 1.
A82448
11.
(a)
(b)
Tape
(a)
FUEL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
10.
(a)
Tape
4 Claws
-
2 Claws
A82449
REMOVE FUEL PUMP ASSY
Disconnect the fuel pump connector.
Using a small screwdriver with its tip wrapped in tape, disconnect the 2 snap-claws from the claw holes and pull
out the fuel pump.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fuel pump and fuel suction plate.
(c) Remove the O-ring and fuel pump spacer from the fuel
pump.
12.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FUEL PUMP FILTER
Using a small screwdriver, pry out the clip.
Remove the fuel filter from the fuel pump.
A79771
13.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FUEL TUBE JOINT NO.1
Disconnect the connector.
Using a screwdriver with its tip wrapped in tape, disconnect the snap-claw from the claw hole and pull out the
fuel tube joint.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fuel tube joint and fuel suction plate.
Tape
(a)
Claw
A82453
14.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL PUMP HARNESS
Remove the harness from the fuel tube joint No. 1.
A79773
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2402
11-19
FUEL
15.
(a)
(b)
Clip
(c)
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
REMOVE FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR ASSY
Remove the clip.
Pull out the pressure regulator from the fuel tube joint No.
1.
Remove the 2 O-rings from the fuel tube joint No. 1.
A79774
16.
(a)
New O-Ring
(b)
(c)
INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR ASSY
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to the 2 new
O-rings, and install them to the fuel pressure regulator.
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to the 2 O-rings
again, and install the fuel pressure regulator to the fuel
tube joint No. 1.
Install the clip.
A79775
17.
INSTALL FUEL PUMP HARNESS
18.
(a)
New O-Ring
(b)
(c)
INSTALL FUEL TUBE JOINT NO.1
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to a new Oring, and install it to the fuel tube joint No. 1.
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to the O-ring
again, and install the fuel tube joint No. 1 to the fuel suction plate.
Connect the connector.
A79776
19.
(a)
INSTALL FUEL PUMP FILTER
Install the fuel filter with a new clip.
20.
(a)
(b)
New O-Ring
(c)
Fuel Pump
Spacer
(d)
INSTALL FUEL PUMP ASSY
Install the fuel pump spacer to the fuel pump.
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to a new Oring, and install it to the fuel pump.
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to a the O-ring
again, and install the fuel pump to the fuel suction plate.
Connect the fuel pump connector.
A81604
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2403
11-20
FUEL
21.
(a)
New O-Ring
(b)
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL FUEL SUCTION PLATE SUB-ASSY
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to a new Oring, and install it to the fuel tube joint No. 1.
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to the O-ring
again, and install the fuel suction plate to the fuel suction
support No. 1.
A79777
22.
INSTALL FUEL SENDER GAGE ASSY
Keyway
Key
A81637
”S” Mark
23.
INSTALL FUEL SUCTION TUBE ASSY W/ PUMP &
GAGE
(a) Install a new gasket to the fuel tank.
(b) Attach the fuel suction tube to the fuel tank.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend the arm of the fuel sender gage.
(c) Align the keyway of the fuel suction tube support with the
key of the fuel suction tube.
(d) Apply MP grease to the entire interior surface of the fuel
pump gage retainer.
(e) Align the triangle mark on new fuel pump gage retainer
with the ”S” mark on the fuel tank while pushing down the
fuel suction tube, attach the fuel pump gage retainer.
Triangle Mark
A82455
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2404
11-21
FUEL
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(f)
Rotate the fuel pump gage retainer by hand, then tighten
it one complete turn and half using SST. Triangle mark on
the fuel pump gage retainer must be positioned between
”A” and ”MAX.” indications on the fuel tank.
SST 09808- 14020 (09808- 01410, 09808- 01420,
09808-01430)
NOTICE:
Do not use other tools in this operation. Damage to the fuel
pump gage retainer and the fuel tank may result.
HINT:
A rib on the fuel pump gage retainer can be fitted into a tip of
the SST.
SST
Rib
Triangle Mark
”A” Mark
”MAX.” Mark
A93073
(g)
24.
Connect the fuel pump tube.
(1) Install the fuel pump tube and the tube joint clip.
NOTICE:
Check that there are no scratches or foreign objects
on the connecting part.
Collar
Check that the fuel tube joint is inserted securely.
Check that the tube joint clip is on the collar of the fuel
tube joint.
Tube Joint Clip
After installing the tube joint clip, check that the fuel
A81640
tube joint has not been pulled off.
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page 11-4 )
25.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
Install a new butyl tape to the rear floor service hole cover.
Connect the fuel pump & sender gage connector.
Install the rear floor service hole cover.
New Butyl Tape
A81633
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
INSTALL REAR SEAT ASSY LH (See page 72-28 )
INSTALL REAR SEAT ASSY RH (See page 72-35 )
INSTALL REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
INSTALL DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2405
11-22
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
1111V-01
COMPONENTS
w/ Rear No. 2 Seat
Deck Board
Rear Seat Assy RH
Rear Seat Assy LH
Rear Seat
Track Bracket Cover Outer
x2
x4
37 (375, 27)
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer
x4
37 (375, 27)
Rear Door Scuff Plate LH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A92780
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2406
11-23
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
w/o Rear No. 2 Seat:
Deck Board
x5
Clip
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
x3
Clip
Rear Seat Assy RH
Rear Seat Assy LH
Rear Seat
Track Bracket Cover Outer
x2
x4
37 (375, 27)
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer
x4
x2
37 (375, 27)
Rear Door Scuff Plate LH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A92781
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2407
11-24
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Rear Floor Service Hole Cover
Fuel Pump &Sender
Gage Connector
Fuel Pump Tube
Tube Joint Clip
Fuel Pump Gage Retainer
Fuel Suction Tube Assy w/ Pump & Gage
Fuel Suction Tube Gasket
Non-reusable part
A92785
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2408
11-25
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Front Floor Heat Insulator No. 3
4.9 (50, 43 in.⋅lbf)
x4
Exhaust Pipe Gasket Center
Exhaust Pipe Assy Center
x2
Compression
Spring
48 (490, 35)
4WD Type:
Exhaust Pipe Support Bracket No. 4
Exhaust Pipe Gasket
22 (224, 16)
x2
x2
Washer
x4
48 (490, 35)
Compression
Spring
74 (750, 55)
Washer
37 (375, 27)
x4
4WD Type:
Propeller w/ Center Bearing Shaft Assy
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A93064
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2409
11-26
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Fuel Tank Assy
Fuel Tube Protector No. 1
x2
20 (200, 14)
x2
Clip
x2
39 (400, 29)
Fuel Tank Band
Sub-assy RH
x2
39 (400, 29)
Fuel Tank Band
Sub-assy LH
Fuel Tank Protector
Sub-assy No. 1
Clip
x3
x6
5.5 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Fuel Tank Protector No. 1
x4
5.5 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A94218
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2410
11-27
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Tank Suction Tube Support
Fuel Pump Tube Sub-assy
Fuel Tank Vent Hose
Fuel Tank Cushion Set
30 (306, 22)
Fuel Tank Side Plate
x2
Fuel Tank
to Filler Pipe Hose
Fuel Tank Assy
Fuel Tank Cushion No. 5
Fuel Tank Bracket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A94219
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2411
11-28
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
110UL-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page 11-1 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
REMOVE REAR SEAT ASSY RH (See page 72-35 )
REMOVE REAR SEAT ASSY LH (See page 72-28 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
REMOVE REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER (See page 11-16 )
REMOVE FUEL SUCTION TUBE ASSY W/ PUMP & GAGE (See page 11-16 )
DRAIN FUEL
REMOVE PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (4WD TYPE)
(See page 30-4 )
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY CENTER (See page 15-2 )
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR HEAT INSULATOR NO.3 (See page 12-1 1)
13.
(a)
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE SUPPORT BRACKET NO.4
(4WD TYPE)
Remove the 2 bolts and support bracket.
A80549
14.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TUBE PROTECTOR NO.1
Remove the 2 clips and unfasten the claw, and remove
the tube protector.
15.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TANK PROTECTOR NO.1
Remove the 4 nuts and tank protector.
A80550
A80551
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2412
11-29
FUEL
1
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
16.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TANK PROTECTOR SUB-ASSY NO.1
Remove the 3 clips (1), 6 nuts and tank protector.
17.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TANK ASSY
Disconnect the fuel pump tube.
(1) Pinch the projection of the retainer to remove the
lock claws and pull down it as shown in the illustration.
(2) Pull out the fuel pump tube.
1
1
1
A81225
(1)
(1)
(2)
(1)
Retainer
A81688
Quick Connector
Retainer
Nylon Tube
O-ring
Pipe
A81689
NOTICE:
Before this operation, check the connector for dirt,
mud or other contamination. Clean if necessary.
Be careful of mud. The connector’s O-ring, which
seals the pipe and connector, becomes contaminated
easily.
Do not use any tool in this operation.
Do not bend or twist the nylon tube. Protect the connector by covering it with a vinyl or plastic bag.
When the pipe and connector are stuck, push and pull
the connector to release it. Then pull out the connector from the pipe.
(b)
A
(1)
(2)
(2)
Disconnect the fuel tank vent hose.
(1) Push the connector deep into the charcoal canister
to release the locking tab.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
A
A81211
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2413
11-30
FUEL
(c)
(2)
(2)
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Disconnect the fuel tank breather tube No. 3.
(1) Lower the connector checker slightly.
(2) Pinch the tube connector.
(3) Pull out the breather tube.
(3)
(1)
A93428
Nylon Tube
Tube Connector
Pipe
O-Ring
Checker
B79934
NOTICE:
Before this operation, check the connector for dirt,
mud or other contamination. Clean if necessary.
Be careful of mud. The connector’s O-ring, which
seals the pipe and connector, becomes contaminated
easily.
Do not use any tool in this operation.
Do not bend or twist the nylon tube. Protect the connector by covering it with a vinyl or plastic bag.
When the pipe and connector are stuck, push and pull
the connector to release it. Then pull out the connector from the pipe.
(d)
Loosen the hose clamp bolt and disconnect the fuel tank
to filler pipe hose.
A93430
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2414
11-31
FUEL
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Set up a transmission jack under the fuel tank.
Remove the 4 bolts and 2 fuel tank bands.
Remove the 2 nuts.
Operate the transmission jack and remove the fuel tank.
(f)
(f)
(g)
(f)
(f)
(g)
A94220
: 2 Claws
18.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL PUMP TUBE SUB-ASSY
Unfasten the 2 claws and remove the tube.
19.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TANK TO FILLER PIPE HOSE
Loosen the hose clamp bolt and remove the hose.
A81690
A81221
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2415
11-32
FUEL
20.
(a)
(a)
A
(b)
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE FUEL TANK VENT HOSE
Push the connector deep into the charcolal canister to release the locking tab.
Pinch portion A.
Pull out the connector.
Unfasten the claw and remove the vent hose.
21.
(a)
REMOVE TANK SUCTION TUBE SUPPORT
Remove the tube support from the fuel tank.
22.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TANK SIDE PLATE
Remove the bolt and nut side plate and tank bracket.
23.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TANK CUSHION SET
Remove the cushion set and cushion No. 5.
(b)
: Claw
A
A81224
A80561
Side Plate
Tank
Bracket
A82407
Cushion Set
Cushion No. 5
A82470
24.
25.
INSTALL FUEL TANK CUSHION SET
INSTALL FUEL TANK SIDE PLATE
Torque: 30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2416
11-33
FUEL
26.
(a)
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL TANK SUCTION TUBE SUPPORT
Install a new tube support as shown in the illustration.
A82408
27.
28.
29.
INSTALL FUEL TANK VENT HOSE
INSTALL FUEL TANK TO FILLER PIPE HOSE
INSTALL FUEL PUMP TUBE SUB-ASSY
30. INSTALL FUEL TANK ASSY
(a) Set up the fuel tank to the transmission jack.
(b) Operate the transmission jack and the install the fuel tank.
(c) Tighten the 2 nuts.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (200 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
(d) Install the 2 fuel tank bands with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
(e) Install the connector clamp.
(f)
Connect the fuel tank wire connector.
(g) Connect the fuel tank to filler pipe hose.
(h)
(1)
(2)
A94322
Connect the fuel tank breather tube No. 3.
(1) Push the quick connector to the pipe until it makes
”click” sound.
NOTICE:
Check if there is any damage or foreign objects on the
connected part.
After connecting, check if the quick connector and
the pipe are securely connected by trying to pull them
apart.
(2) Return the connecter checker to its original position.
(i)
Connect the fuel tank vent hose.
(j)
(1)
(2)
Retainer
A82411
Connect the fuel pump tube.
(1) Push the quick connector in the direction of the
white arrow.
NOTICE:
Check if there is any damage or foreign objects on the
connected part.
After connecting, check if the quick connector and
the pipe are securely connected by pulling on them.
(2) Push up on the retainer until the claws lock.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2417
11-34
FUEL
31.
(a)
(b)
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
46.
47.
48.
49.
50.
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL FUEL TANK PROTECTOR SUB-ASSY NO.1
Install the tank protector with the 6 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Install 3 new clips.
INSTALL FUEL TANK PROTECTOR NO.1
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL FUEL TUBE PROTECTOR NO.1
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE SUPPORT BRACKET NO.4 (4WD TYPE)
Torque: 22 N⋅m (224 kgf⋅cm, 16 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR HEAT INSULATOR NO.3 (See page 12-1 1)
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY CENTER (See page 15-2 )
ADD FUEL
INSTALL FUEL SUCTION TUBE ASSY W/ PUMP & GAGE (See page 11-16 )
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page 11-4 )
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
INSTALL REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER (See page 11-16 )
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
INSTALL REAR SEAT ASSY LH (See page 72-28 )
INSTALL REAR SEAT ASSY RH (See page 72-35 )
INSTALL REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
INSTALL DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY
INSTALL PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (4WD TYPE)
(See page 30-12 )
FULLY TIGHTEN PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (4WD TYPE)
(See page 30-12 )
ADD TRANSFER OIL (4WD TYPE) (See page 31-4 )
INSPECT TRANSFER OIL (4WD TYPE) (See page 31-4 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2418
11-41
FUEL
-
FUEL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
110UO-04
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
Check the injector resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard: 13.4 to 14.2 Ω at 20C (68F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the injector.
(b) Check the injector injection.
CAUTION:
This test involves high-pressure fuel and electricity.
Take every precaution regarding safe handling of
both the fuel and the electricity.
Perform this test in a safe area, and avoid any sparks
or flame.
Do not smoke.
(1)
Fuel Tube Connector
Purchase a new fuel tube and disconnect fuel tube
connector from its pipe.
Fuel tube: Parts No. 23801-20180
A50710
(2)
Connect SST and the fuel tube connector to the fuel
pipe.
SST 09268-41047
CAUTION:
Always read the precautions (see page 11-35 ) before connecting the fuel tube connector (quick type).
Fuel Tube Connector
SST
(Hose)
B12947
(3)
(4)
Install the O-ring to the injector.
Connect SST (union and hose) to the injector, and
hold the injector and union with SST (clamp).
SST 09268-41047 (09268-41110, 09268-41300)
(5) Put the injector into a graduated cylinder.
SST (Hose)
SST (Union)
O-Ring
SST
(Clamp)
Vinyl Tube
A94173
HINT:
Install a suitable vinyl tube onto the injector to contain the gasoline spray.
(6) Operate the fuel pump (see page 11-38 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2425
11-42
FUEL
-
FUEL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
(7)
(8)
Connect SST to the connector of injector
Connect SST (wire) to the battery for 15 seconds,
and measure the injector volume with a graduated
cylinder. Test each injector 2or 3 time.
SST 09842-30070
Standard:
Item
Specified Condition
Injection Volume
60 to 73 cm3 (3.7 to 4.5 cu in.)
per 15 seconds
Difference Between Each Injector
13 cm3 (0.8 cu in.) or less
A94174
NOTICE:
Always turn on and off the voltage on the battery side, not
the fuel pump side.
If the injection volume is not as specified, replace the injector.
(c)
Check fuel leakage.
(1) In the condition above, disconnect the test probes
of SST (wire) from the battery and check the fuel
leakage from the injector.
Fuel drop: 1 drop or less per 12 minutes
B00069
2.
(a)
(-)
A16628
(+)
A91308
INSPECT FUEL PUMP
Check the fuel pump resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard: 0.2 to 3.0 Ω at 20C (68F)
(b) Check fuel pump operation.
(1) Apply battery voltage to both terminals. Check that
the pump operates.
NOTICE:
These tests must be done within 10 seconds to prevent the coil from burning out.
Keep the fuel pump as far away from the battery as
possible.
Always turn on and off the voltage on the battery side,
not the fuel pump side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2426
11-38
FUEL
-
FUEL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
110UN-04
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
CHECK FUEL PUMP OPERATION AND FUEL LEAKS
When using the hand-held tester:
Check fuel pump operation.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the hand-held
tester main switch ON.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(3) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the hand-held
tester.
(4) Please refer to the hand-held tester’s instruction
manual for further details.
(5) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(6) Disconnect the hand-held tester from the DLC3.
(b)
FP
+B
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
Circuit Opening
Relay
A92782
When not using the hand-held tester:
Check fuel pump operation.
(1) Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B subassy.
(2) Using a service wire, connect terminals FP and +B
of the R/B sub-assy.
NOTICE:
Pay close attention to the terminal connecting position to
avoid a malfunction.
(3) Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the fuel
pump operates.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(c) Check that there are no fuel leaks after doing maintenance anywhere on the fuel system.
(d) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(e) Remove the servive wire from the R/B sub-assy.
(f)
Install the circuit opening relay to the R/B sub-assy.
2.
(a)
(b)
Fuel Tube Connector
(c)
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
Check that the battery positive voltage is above 12 V.
Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
Purchase a new fuel tube and take out the fuel tube connector from its pipe.
Fuel tube: Part No. 23801-20180
A50710
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2422
11-39
FUEL
(d)
Fuel Pipe
Clamp No. 1
-
FUEL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Remove the fuel pipe clamp No. 1 from the fuel tube connector.
A60083
(e)
Disconnect the fuel tube connector from the fuel pipe by
pinching part A with fingers, as shown in the illustration.
CAUTION:
Always read the precautions (see page 11-35 ) before
disconnecting the fuel tube connector (quick type).
The fuel pipe line may spray fuel as a result of retained pressure that remains in it. Do not allow fuel to
be sprayed in the engine compartment.
A
A
B12941
(f)
SST
(Clip)
SST
SST (T-Joint)
Fuel Tube
SST
(Hose)
Fuel Tube Connector
A93071
Install SST (pressure gauge) and fuel tube connecter using SST as shown in the illustration.
SST 09268-41047, 09268-45014 (09268-41250)
(g) Wipe up any gasoline.
(h) Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
(i)
When using the hand-held tester:
Operate the fuel pump (see step 1 (a)).
(j)
When not using the hand-held tester:
Operate the fuel pump (see step 1 (b)).
(k) Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure:
304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 50 psi)
If the pressure is high, replace the fuel pressure regulator.
If the pressure is low, check the fuel hoses and connections,
fuel pump, fuel filter and fuel pressure regulator.
(l)
Start the engine.
(m) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure:
304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 50 psi)
(n) Stop the engine.
(o) Check that the fuel pressure remains as specified for 5
minutes after the engine has stopped.
Fuel pressure: 147 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm2, 21 psi)
If the pressure is not as specified, check the fuel pump, pressure regulator and/or injectors.
(p) After checking the fuel pressure, disconnect the negative
(-) battery cable and carefully remove SST and fuel tube
connector to prevent gasoline from spraying.
(q) Reconnect the fuel inlet tube (fuel tube connector).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2423
11-40
FUEL
-
FUEL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CAUTION:
Always read the precautions (see page 11-35 ) before connecting the fuel tube connector (quick type).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2424
11-35
FUEL
-
FUEL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
FUEL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
110UM-04
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Before working on the fuel system, disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
Do not smoke or be near an open flame when working on the fuel system.
Keep gasoline away from rubber or leather parts.
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
CAUTION:
Do not disconnect any part of the fuel system until
you have discharged the fuel system pressure.
Even after discharging the fuel pressure, place a
shop rag over fittings as you separate them to reduce
risk of fuel spray on yourself or in the engine compartment.
R/B Sub-assy
Circuit Opening
Relay
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
A93007
(a)
(b)
Remove the circuit opening relay from the R/B sub-assy.
Start the engine. After the engine has stopped, turn the
ignition switch OFF.
HINT:
There is a case that DTC P0171 (system to lean) is output.
(c) Check that the engine does not start.
(d) Remove the fuel tank cap, and allow the air out of the fuel
tank.
(e) Reinstall the circuit opening relay.
2.
(a)
FUEL SYSTEM
When disconnecting the high fuel pressure line, a large
amount of gasoline will spill out, so observe these procedures.
(1) Perform the step 2 to prevent gasoline from spilling
out.
(2) Put a container under the connection.
(3) Disconnect the fuel pump tube (see page 11-55 ).
(4) Drain the fuel remaining inside the fuel pump tube.
(5)
To protect the disconnected fuel pump tube from
damage and contamination, cover it with a vinyl
bag.
B00679
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2419
11-36
FUEL
New O-Ring
CORRECT
-
FUEL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
(b)
Observe the following precautions when removing and
installing the fuel injectors.
(1) Never reuse O-rings.
(2) When installing a new O-ring on the injector, be
careful not to damage it.
(3) Coat new O-rings with grease or gasoline before
installing. Never use engine oil, gear oil or brake oil.
(c)
Install the injector to the delivery pipe and cylinder head,
as shown in the illustration. Before installing the injector,
be sure to apply grease or gasoline on the place where
the delivery pipe touches the O-ring of the injector.
(d)
Observe these precautions when disconnecting the fuel
tube connectors.
(1) Remove the fuel pipe clamp from the connector.
(2) Check for dirt or mud on the pipe and around the
connector before disconnection. Clean if necessary.
Grommet Delivery Pipe
Injector
INCORRECT
A94329
Delilvery Pipe
O-Ring
Grommet
Spacer
Insulator
A62371
Fuel Pipe
Clamp No. 1
A60083
(3)
Disconnect the connector from the hose while
pinching part A with fingers, as shown in the illustration.
(4)
If the connector and the pipe are stuck, pinch the
fuel pipe, push and pull the connector to disconnect
it and pull it out. Do not use any tools.
If dirt or any other substance is found on the sealing
surface that might interfere with the seal, clean the
area thoroughly before assembly.
A
A
B12941
(5)
B12944
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2420
11-37
FUEL
-
(6)
Vinyl or Plastic Bag
FUEL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
To protect the disconnected pipe and connector
from damage and contamination, cover it with a vinyl bag.
A79119
(e)
Push
A71366
Observe these precautions when connecting the fuel
tube connector.
(1) Check that there is no damage or contamination in
the connected part of the pipe.
(2) Align the axis of the connector with the axis of the
pipe. Push the pipe into the connector until the connector makes a ”click” sound. If the connection is
tight, apply little amount of fresh engine oil on the tip
of the pipe.
(3)
(4)
(5)
Pull
After having finished the connection, check if the
pipe and the connector are securely connected by
trying to pull them apart.
Install the fuel pipe clamp to the connector.
Check if there is any fuel leakage.
A71366
3.
(a)
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS
Check that there are no fuel leaks after doing maintenance anywhere on the fuel system (see page
11-38 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2421
11-43
FUEL
-
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
110XH-02
COMPONENTS
7.9 (81, 70 in.⋅lbf)
x3
V-Bank Cover Sub-assy
Fuel Vapor Feed Hose Assy
Vacuum Hose
MAF Meter
Connector
Vacuum Hose
Air Cleaner Cap
Sub-assy
Air Cleaner Filter
Element Sub-assy
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A93429
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2427
11-44
FUEL
-
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
VSV Connector
7.8 (80, 69 in.⋅lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
x3
Pressure Feed
Tube Assy
x2
Fuel Vapor Feed Hose
Emission Control Valve Set
28 (286, 21)
20 (204, 15)
x3
20 (204, 15)
x2
x2
x2
Emission Control Valve Bracket
Surge Tank Stay
x2
No. 1
Engine Hanger No. 1
20 (204, 15)
Intake Air Surge Tank
Surge Tank Stay
No. 2
Union to Check Valve Hose
Throttle Motor Connector
Gasket
Water By-pass Hose No. 3
Water By-pass Hose No. 2
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A81592
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2428
11-45
FUEL
Fuel Injector O-ring
Fuel Injector Grommet
-
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
10 (102, 7)
Fuel Injector Assy
Fuel Injector
Connector
Fuel Delivery Pipe
Sub-assy
Injector Vibration Insulator
Delivery Pipe No. 1 Spacer
10 (102, 7)
Fuel Delivery Pipe No. 2
20 (204, 15)
Fuel Pump Hose Gasket
Fuel Pressure
Pulsation Damper Assy
Injector Vibration Insulator
33 (337, 24)
Fuel Pipe Sub-assy No. 1
Fuel Pipe
No. 2 Gasket
33 (337, 24)
Fuel Injector
Connector
Delivery Pipe No. 1 Spacer
Fuel Pipe No. 2 Union Bolt
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A81676
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2429
11-46
FUEL
-
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
110XI-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
(a)
4.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page 11-35 )
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER (w/ Performance Rod)
Remove the 2 nuts and upper brace.
REMOVE V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
(c)
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(f)
(a)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(e)
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
Disconnect the 3 vacuum hoses.
Disconnect the ventilation hose No. 2.
Loosen the air cleaner hose clamp bolt, and remove the
air cleaner cap.
Remove the air cleaner filter element.
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
Disconnect the 2 VSV connectors.
Remove the wire harness clamp.
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
Disconnect the fuel vapor feed hose No. 1.
Disconnect the fuel vapor feed hose No. 2.
Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses.
Remove the clamp.
Remove the 2 nuts and the emission control valve set.
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
Disconnect the throttle motor connector.
Disconnect the water by-pass hose No. 3.
Disconnect the water by-pass hose No. 2.
Disconnect the union to check valve hose.
A93066
(a)
(b)
(a)
A79751
(d)
(e)
(e)
(f)
(c)
A82428
(d)
(a)
(c)
(b)
A81623
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2430
11-47
FUEL
-
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(e)
Disconnect the ventilation hose.
(f)
Remove the 3 nuts and separate the pressure feed tube.
(g)
(h)
(i)
Remove the 2 bolts and engine hanger No. 1.
Remove the 2 bolts and surge tank stay No. 1.
Remove the 2 bolts and surge tank stay No. 2.
(j)
(k)
Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, remove the 4 bolts.
Remove the 2 nuts, emission control valve bracket and intake air surge tank.
Remove the gasket from the intake air surge tank.
(e)
A79706
(f)
A81678
(h)
(g)
(i)
A81674
(l)
A82427
8.
(a)
(b)
(b)
(c)
(c)
SEPARATE FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSY NO.1
Remove the bolt and disconnect the fuel pipe No. 1.
Remove the fuel pressure pulsation damper and 2 gaskets.
Remove the fuel pipe No. 2 union bolt and 2 gaskets.
(a)
A79710
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2431
11-48
FUEL
9.
(a)
-
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
Disconnect the 6 fuel injector connectors.
A82436
(b)
Remove the 4 bolts and 2 fuel delivery pipes together with
the 6 fuel injectors.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the fuel injectors when removing the
fuel delivery pipe.
A82437
2
(c)
Remove the 4 delivery pipe No. 1 spacers (1) and 6 insulators (2) from the intake manifold.
(d)
Pull out the fuel injector from the fuel delivery pipe.
10.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL FUEL INJECTOR ASSY
Install a new grommet to each injector.
Apply a light coat of grease or gasoline to a new O-ring,
and install it to each injector.
1
2
A82446
A81137
New O-Ring
New Grommet
A79762
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2432
11-49
FUEL
-
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(c)
Apply a light coat of grease or gasoline on the place
where the fuel delivery pipe contacts the O-ring.
(d) Push the fuel injector while twisting it back and forth to
install it in the fuel delivery pipe.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to twist the O-ring.
After installing the fuel injector, check that it turns
smoothly. If not, reinstall it with a new O-ring.
Turn
Push
A81139
(e)
11.
(a)
(b)
(c)
12.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
Install 6 new insulators and the 4 delivery pipe No. 1
spacers to the intake manifold.
(f)
Place the 2 fuel delivery pipes and 6 fuel injectors together on the intake manifold.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the fuel injectors when installing the
fuel delivery pipe.
(g) Temporarily install the 4 bolts which are used to attach the
Turn
fuel delivery pipe to the intake manifold.
A82447
NOTICE:
After installing the fuel injector, check that it turns smoothly. If not, reinstall it with a new O-ring.
(h) Tighten the 4 bolts.
Torque: 10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf)
(i)
Connect the 6 fuel injector connectors.
INSTALL FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSY NO.1
Install 2 new gaskets and the fuel pipe No. 2 union bolt.
Torque: 33 N⋅m (337 kgf⋅cm, 24 ft⋅lbf)
Install 2 new gaskets and the fuel pressure pulsation damper.
Torque: 33 N⋅m (337 kgf⋅cm, 24 ft⋅lbf)
Install the fuel pipe No. 1 with the bolt.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
Install a new gasket to the intake air surge tank.
Install the intake air surge tank and emission control valve bracket with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, tighten the 4 bolts.
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
Install the surge tank stay No. 2 with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Install the surge tank stay No. 1 with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Install the engine hanger No. 1 with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Install the pressure feed tube with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 7.8 N⋅m (80 kgf⋅cm, 69 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the ventilation hose.
Connect the union to check valve hose.
Connect the water bypass hose No. 2.
Connect the water bypass hose No. 3.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2433
11-50
FUEL
(l)
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
(a)
-
FUEL INJECTOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Connect the throttle motor connector.
INSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
CHECK CONNECTION OF VACUUM HOSE (See page 14-149 )
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-20 )
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page 11-38 )
INSTALL V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER (w/ Performance Rod)
Install the upper brace with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 80 N⋅m (815 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2434
11-51
FUEL
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
FUEL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
1111W-01
COMPONENTS
w/ Rear No. 2 Seat
Deck Board
Rear Seat Assy RH
Seat Track Bracket
Cover Inner
Rear Seat Assy LH
Rear Seat
Track Bracket Cover Outer
x2
x4
37 (375, 27)
Seat Track Bracket
Cover Inner
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer
x4
37 (375, 27)
Rear Door Scuff Plate LH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A92780
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2435
11-52
FUEL
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
w/o Rear No. 2 Seat
Deck Board
x5
Clip
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
x3
Rear Seat Assy RH
Clip
Rear Seat Assy LH
Rear Seat
Track Bracket Cover Outer
x2
x4
37 (375, 27)
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer
x4
x2
37 (375, 27)
Rear Door Scuff Plate LH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A92781
A81630
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2436
11-53
FUEL
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Rear Floor Service Hole Cover
Fuel Pump & Sender
Gauge Connector
Fuel Pump Tube
Tube Joint Clip
Fuel Pump Gage Retainer
Fuel Suction Tube Assy w/ Pump & Gage
Fuel Suction Tube Gasket
Non-reusable part
A92785
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2437
11-54
FUEL
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Fuel Suction Plate
Sub-assy
Fuel Pump Harness
O-Ring
Fuel Pump Spacer
Clip
Fuel Pump
O-Ring
Fuel Tube Joint
No. 1
Fuel Pressure
Regulator Assy
Fuel Filter Assy
O-Ring
O-Ring
Clip
Fuel Suction Support No. 1
Fuel Sender Gage
Assy
Non-reusable part
A81632
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2438
11-55
FUEL
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
1111X-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page 11-35 )
2.
(a)
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY
Disengage the 5 clips and turn up the front side of the
deck board.
B51632
3.
4.
5.
6.
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
REMOVE REAR SEAT ASSY RH (See page 72-35 )
REMOVE REAR SEAT ASSY LH (See page 72-28 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
7.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
Remove the rear floor service hole cover.
Disconnect the fuel pump & sender gauge connector.
8.
REMOVE FUEL SUCTION TUBE ASSY W/ PUMP &
GAGE
Disconnect the fuel pump tube.
(1) Remove the tube joint clip, and pull out the fuel
pump tube.
A81633
Tube Joint Clip
(a)
A81634
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2439
11-56
FUEL
Nylon Tube
Fuel Tube Joint
O-Ring
Tube Joint Clip
Fuel Suction Plate
A81635
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
NOTICE:
Before this operation, check the connector for dirt,
mud or other contamination. Clean if necessary.
Be careful of mud. The connector’s O-ring, which
seals the pipe and connector, becomes contaminated
easily.
Do not use any tool in this operation.
Do not bend or twist the nylon tube. Protect the connector by covering it with a vinyl or plastic bag.
When the pipe and connector are stuck, push and pull
the connector to release it. Then pull the connector
from the pipe.
(b)
SST
Rib
A81636
Using SST, loosen the fuel pump gage retainer.
SST 09808- 14020 (09808- 01410, 09808- 01420,
09808-01430)
NOTICE:
Loosen the retainer by turning it counterclockwise while
holding the SST down. Do not allow the claw of the tank
suction tube support to slip out of its groove on the fuel
tank.
HINT:
A rib on the fuel pump gage retainer can be fitted into a tip of
the SST.
(c) Remove the fuel pump gage retainer.
(d) Remove the fuel suction tube.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend the arm of the fuel sender gage.
(e) Remove the gasket from the fuel tank.
A80531
9.
(a)
(b)
Unlock
REMOVE FUEL SENDER GAGE ASSY
Disconnect the fuel sender gage connector.
Unlock the fuel sender gage and slide it to remove.
(a)
Slide
A79768
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2440
11-57
FUEL
REMOVE FUEL SUCTION PLATE SUB-ASSY
Using a screwdriver with the its wrapped in tape, disconnect the 4 snap-claws from the claw holes and remove
the fuel suction plate.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fuel suction plate and fuel suction support No. 1.
A82448
11.
(a)
(b)
Tape
(a)
FUEL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
10.
(a)
Tape
4 Claws
-
2 Claws
A82449
REMOVE FUEL PUMP ASSY
Disconnect the fuel pump connector.
Using a small screwdriver with the its wrapped in tape,
disconnect the 2 snap-claws from the claw holes and pull
out the fuel pump.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fuel pump and fuel suction plate.
(c) Remove the O-ring and fuel pump spacer from the fuel
pump.
12.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FUEL PUMP FILTER
Using a small screwdriver, pry out the clip.
Remove the fuel filter from the fuel pump.
A79771
13.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FUEL TUBE JOINT NO.1
Disconnect the connector.
Using a screwdriver with the its wrapped in tape, disconnect the snap-claw from the claw hole and pull out the
fuel tube joint.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fuel tube joint and fuel suction plate.
Tape
(a)
Claw
A82453
14.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL PUMP HARNESS
Remove the harness from the fuel tube joint No. 1.
A79773
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2441
11-58
FUEL
15.
(a)
(b)
Clip
(c)
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR ASSY
Remove the clip.
Pull out the pressure regulator from the fuel tube joint No.
1.
Remove the 2 O-rings from the fuel tube joint No. 1.
A79774
16.
(a)
New O-Ring
(b)
(c)
INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR ASSY
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to the 2 new
O-rings, and install them to the fuel pressure regulator.
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to the 2 O-rings
again, and install the fuel pressure regulator to the fuel
tube joint No. 1.
Install the clip.
A79775
17.
INSTALL FUEL PUMP HARNESS
18.
(a)
New O-ring
(b)
(c)
INSTALL FUEL TUBE JOINT NO.1
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to a new Oring, and install it to the fuel tube joint No. 1.
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to the O-ring
again, and install the fuel tube joint No. 1 to the fuel suction plate.
Connect the connector.
A79776
19.
(a)
INSTALL FUEL PUMP FILTER
Install the fuel filter with a new clip.
20.
(a)
(b)
New O-Ring
(c)
Fuel Pump
Spacer
(d)
INSTALL FUEL PUMP ASSY
Install the fuel pump spacer to the fuel pump.
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to a new Oring, and install it to the fuel pump.
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to the O-ring
again, and install the fuel pump to the fuel suction plate.
Connect the fuel pump connector.
A81604
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2442
11-59
FUEL
21.
(a)
New O-Ring
(b)
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL FUEL SUCTION PLATE SUB-ASSY
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to a new Oring, and install it to the fuel tube joint No. 1.
Apply a light coat of gasoline or spindle oil to the O-ring
again, and install the fuel suction plate to the fuel suction
support No. 1.
A79777
22.
INSTALL FUEL SENDER GAGE ASSY
Keyway
Key
A81637
”S” Mark
23.
INSTALL FUEL SUCTION TUBE ASSY W/ PUMP &
GAGE
(a) Install a new gasket to the fuel tank.
(b) Attach the fuel suction tube to the fuel tank.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend the arm of the fuel sender gage.
(c) Align the keyway of the fuel suction tube support with the
key of the fuel suction tube.
(d) Apply MP grease to the entire interior surface of the fuel
pump gage retainer.
(e) Align the triangle mark on new fuel pump gauge retainer
with the ”S” mark on the fuel tank while pushing down the
fuel suction tube, attach the fuel pump gauge retainer.
Triangle Mark
A82455
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2443
11-60
FUEL
-
FUEL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(f)
Rotate the fuel pump gage retainer by hand, then tighten
it one complete turn and half using SST. Triangle mark on
the fuel pump gauge retainer must be positioned between
”A” and ”MAX.” indications on the fuel tank.
NOTICE:
Do not use other tools in this operation. Damage to the fuel
pump gage retainer and the fuel tank may result.
HINT:
A rib on the fuel pump gage retainer can be fitted into a tip of
the SST.
SST
Rib
Triangle Mark
”A” Mark
”MAX.” Mark
A93073
(g)
24.
Connect the fuel pump tube.
(1) Install the fuel pump tube and the tube joint clip.
NOTICE:
Check that there are no scratches or foreign objects
on the connecting part.
Collar
Check that the fuel tube joint is inserted securely.
Check that the tube joint clip is on the collar of the fuel
tube joint.
Tube Joint Clip
After installing the tube joint clip, check that the fuel
A81640
tube joint has not been pulled off.
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page 11-38 )
25.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
Install a new butyl tape to the rear floor service hole cover.
Connect the fuel pump & sender gage connector.
Install the rear floor service hole cover.
New Butyl Tape
A81633
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
INSTALL REAR SEAT ASSY LH (See page 72-28 )
INSTALL REAR SEAT ASSY RH (See page 72-35 )
INSTALL REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
INSTALL DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2444
11-61
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
1111Y-01
COMPONENTS
w/ Rear No. 2 Seat
Deck Board
Rear Seat Assy RH
Rear Seat Assy LH
Rear Seat
Track Bracket Cover Outer
x2
x4
37 (375, 27)
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer
x4
37 (375, 27)
Rear Door Scuff Plate LH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A92780
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2445
11-62
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
w/o Rear No. 2 Seat:
Deck Board
x5
Clip
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
x3
Clip
Rear Seat Assy RH
Rear Seat Assy LH
Rear Seat
Track Bracket Cover Outer
x2
x4
37 (375, 27)
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer
x4
x2
37 (375, 27)
Rear Door Scuff Plate LH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A92781
A81630
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2446
11-63
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Rear Floor Service Hole Cover
Fuel Pump &Sender
Gage Connector
Fuel Pump Tube
Tube Joint Clip
Fuel Pump Gage Retainer
Fuel Suction Tube Assy w/ Pump & Gage
Fuel Suction Tube Gasket
Non-reusable part
A92785
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2447
11-64
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Front Floor Heat Insulator No. 3
4.9 (50, 43 in.⋅lbf)
x4
Exhaust Pipe Gasket Center
Exhaust Pipe Assy Center
x2
Compression
Spring
48 (490, 35)
4WD Type:
Exhaust Pipe Support Bracket No. 4
Exhaust Pipe Gasket
22 (224, 16)
x2
x2
Washer
x4
48 (490, 35)
Compression
Spring
74 (750, 55)
Washer
37 (375, 27)
x4
4WD Type:
Propeller w/ Center Bearing Shaft Assy
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A93064
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2448
11-65
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Fuel Tank Assy
Fuel Tube Protector No. 1
x2
20 (200, 14)
x2
Clip
x2
39 (400, 29)
Fuel Tank Band
Sub-assy RH
x2
39 (400, 29)
Fuel Tank Band
Sub-assy LH
Fuel Tank Protector
Sub-assy No. 1
Clip
x3
x6
5.5 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Fuel Tank Protector No. 1
x4
5.5 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A81215
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2449
11-66
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Fuel Tank Wire
Vapor Pressure Sensor Assy
Tube Joint Clip
Tank Suction Tube Support
Fuel Pump Tube Sub-assy
Fuel Tank Vent Hose
Fuel Tank Cushion Set
30 (306, 22)
Fuel Tank Side Plate
x2
Fuel Tank
to Filler Pipe Hose
Fuel Tank Assy
Fuel Tank Cushion No. 5
Fuel Tank Bracket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A81216
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2450
11-67
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
110UL-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page 11-35 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
REMOVE REAR SEAT ASSY RH (See page 72-35 )
REMOVE REAR SEAT ASSY LH (See page 72-28 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
REMOVE REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER (See page 11-55 )
REMOVE FUEL SUCTION TUBE ASSY W/ PUMP & GAGE (See page 11-55 )
DRAIN FUEL
REMOVE PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (4WD TYPE)
(See page 30-4 )
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY CENTER (See page 15-5 )
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR HEAT INSULATOR NO.3 (See page 12-28 )
13.
(a)
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE SUPPORT BRACKET NO.4
(4WD TYPE)
Remove the 2 bolts and support bracket.
A80549
14.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TUBE PROTECTOR NO.1
Remove the 2 clips and unfasten the claw, and remove
the tube protector.
15.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TANK PROTECTOR NO.1
Remove the 4 nuts and fuel tank protector.
A80550
A80551
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2451
11-68
FUEL
1
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
16.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TANK PROTECTOR SUB-ASSY NO.1
Remove the 3 clips (1), 6 nuts and tank protector.
17.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TANK ASSY
Disconnect the fuel pump tube.
(1) Pinch the projection of the retainer to remove the
lock claws and pull down it as shown in the illustration.
(2) Pull out the fuel pump tube.
1
1
1
A81225
(1)
(1)
(2)
(1)
Retainer
A81688
Quick Connector
Retainer
Nylon Tube
O-ring
Pipe
A81689
NOTICE:
Before this operation, check the connector for dirt,
mud or other contamination. Clean if necessary.
Be careful of mud. The connector’s O-ring, which
seals the pipe and connector, becomes contaminated
easily.
Do not use any tool in this operation.
Do not bend or twist the nylon tube. Protect the connector by covering it with a vinyl or plastic bag.
When the pipe and connector are stuck, push and pull
the connector to release it. Then pull out the connector from the pipe.
(b)
A
(1)
(2)
(2)
Disconnect the fuel tank vent hose hose.
(1) Push the connector deep into the charcoal canister
to release the locking tab.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
A
A81211
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2452
11-69
FUEL
(c)
(2)
(2)
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Disconnect the fuel tank breather tube No.3.
(1) Lower the connector checker slightly.
(2) Pinch the tube connector.
(3) Pull out the breather tube.
(3)
(1)
A93428
Nylon Tube
Tube Connector
Pipe
O-Ring
Checker
B79934
NOTICE:
Before this operation, check the connector for dirt,
mud or other contamination. Clean if necessary.
Be careful of mud. The connector’s O-ring, which
seals the pipe and connector, becomes contaminated
easily.
Do not use any tool in this operation.
Do not bend or twist the nylon tube. Protect the connector by covering it with a vinyl or plastic bag.
When the pipe and connector are stuck, push and pull
the connector to release it. Then pull out the connector from the pipe.
(d)
Loosen the hose clamp bolt and disconnect the fuel tank
to filler pipe hose.
A93430
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2453
11-70
FUEL
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Disconnect the fuel tank wire connector.
Remove the connector clamp.
Set up a transmission jack under the fuel tank.
Remove the 4 bolts and 2 fuel tank bands.
Remove the 2 nuts.
Operate the transmission jack and remove the fuel tank.
(f)
(h)
(e)
(h)
(i)
(h)
(h)
(i)
A81220
18.
(a)
: 2 Claws
REMOVE FUEL PUMP TUBE SUB-ASSY
Unfasten the 2 claws and remove the tube.
A81690
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2454
11-71
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
19.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TANK TO FILLER PIPE HOSE
Loosen the hose clamp bolt and remove the hose.
20.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FUEL TANK WIRE
Disconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector.
Unfasten the 4 claws and remove the wire.
21.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR ASSY
Remove the tube joint clip.
Pull out the vapor pressure sensor.
22.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE FUEL TANK VENT HOSE
Push the connector deep into the charcoal canister to release the locking tab.
Pinch portion A.
Pull out the connector.
Unfasten the claw and remove the vent hose.
23.
(a)
REMOVE TANK SUCTION TUBE SUPPORT
Remove the tube support from the fuel tank.
A81221
: 4 Claws
A81222
(b)
(a)
Tube Joint Clip
A81223
(a)
A
(b)
(b)
: Claw
A
A81224
A80561
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2455
11-72
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
24.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TANK SIDE PLATE
Remove the bolt and nut, and then remove the fuel tank
side plate and the fuel tank bracket.
25.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL TANK CUSHION SET
Remove the cushion set and cushion No. 5.
Side Plate
Tank
Bracket
A82407
Cushion Set
Cushion No. 5
A82470
26.
27.
INSTALL FUEL TANK CUSHION SET
INSTALL FUEL TANK SIDE PLATE
Torque: 30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
28.
(a)
INSTALL TANK SUCTION TUBE SUPPORT
Install a new tube support as shown in the illustration.
A82408
29.
INSTALL FUEL TANK VENT HOSE
(a)
(b)
Collar
Tube Joint Clip
A82409
30. INSTALL VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR ASSY
(a) Push and hold down the vapor pressure sensor.
(b) Install the fuel tube joint clip to the sensor.
NOTICE:
Check that there are no scratches or foreign objects
on the connecting parts.
Check that the fuel tube joint is fully inserted.
Check that the fuel tube joint clip is on the collar of the
fuel tube joint.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2456
11-73
FUEL
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(1)
(2)
A94322
Connect the fuel pump tube.
(1) Push the quick connector in the direction of the
white arrow.
NOTICE:
Check if there is any damage or foreign objects on the
(2)
connected part.
After connecting, check if the quick connector and
the pipe are securely connected by trying to pull
Retainer
them.
A82411
(2) Push up on the retainer until the claws lock.
INSTALL FUEL TANK PROTECTOR SUB-ASSY NO.1
Install the tank protector with the 6 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Install 3 new clips.
INSTALL FUEL TANK PROTECTOR NO.1
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL FUEL TUBE PROTECTOR NO.1
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE SUPPORT BRACKET NO.4 (4WD TYPE)
Torque: 22 N⋅m (224 kgf⋅cm, 16 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR HEAT INSULATOR NO.3 (See page 12-28 )
(1)
35.
(a)
(b)
36.
37.
38.
39.
After installing the tube joint clip, check if the fuel
joint is securely connected by trying to pull it.
31. INSTALL FUEL TANK WIRE
32. INSTALL FUEL TANK TO FILLER PIPE HOSE
33. INSTALL FUEL PUMP TUBE SUB-ASSY
34. INSTALL FUEL TANK ASSY
(a) Set up the fuel tank to the transmission jack.
(b) Operate the transmission jack and install the fuel tank.
(c) Tighten the 2 nuts.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (200 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
(d) Install the 2 fuel tank bands with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
(e) Install the connector clamp.
(f)
Connect the fuel tank wire connector.
(g) Connect the fuel tank to filler pipe hose.
(h) Connect the fuel tank breather tube No. 3.
(1) Push the quick connector to the pipe until it makes
”click” sound.
NOTICE:
Check if there is any damage or foreign objects on the
connected part.
After connecting, check if the quick connector and
the pipe are securely connected by trying to pull them
apart.
(2) Return the connecter checker to its original position.
(i)
Connect the fuel tank vent hose.
(j)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2457
11-74
FUEL
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
46.
47.
48.
49.
50.
51.
52.
53.
54.
-
FUEL TANK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY CENTER (See page 15-5 )
ADD FUEL
INSTALL FUEL SUCTION TUBE ASSY W/ PUMP & GAGE (See page 11-55 )
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page 11-38 )
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
INSTALL REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER (See page 11-55 )
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
INSTALL REAR SEAT ASSY LH (See page 72-28 )
INSTALL REAR SEAT ASSY RH (See page 72-35 )
INSTALL REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
INSTALL DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY
INSTALL PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (4WD TYPE)
(See page 30-4 )
FULLY TIGHTEN PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (4WD TYPE)
(See page 30-4 )
ADD TRANSFER OIL (4WD TYPE) (See page 31-4 )
INSPECT TRANSFER OIL (4WD TYPE) (See page 31-4 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2458
12-6
EMISSION CONTROL
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
120E3-01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY
Install a clean hose to the ventilation valve.
Check ventilation valve operation.
(1) Blow air into the cylinder head side, and check that
air passes through easily.
CAUTION:
Do not suck air through the valve. Petroleum substances
inside the valve are harmful.
Cylinder Head Side
Clean Hose
A92662
(2)
Blow air into the intake manifold side, and check
that air passes through with difficulty.
If operation is not as specified, replace the ventilation valve.
(c) Remove the hose from the ventilation valve.
Intake Manifold Side
Clean Hose
A92661
2.
(a)
INSPECT FUEL TANK CAP ASSY
Visually check if the cap and gasket are deformed or damaged.
If necessary, repair or replace the cap and/or gasket.
Gasket
A92657
3.
(a)
INSPECT CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY
Visually check the charcoal canister for cracks or damage.
If cracks or damage is found, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
A92445
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2464
12-7
EMISSION CONTROL
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
(b)
Vent Port
Air Inlet Port
Air
Purge Port
Check charcoal canister operation.
(1) While holding the purge port closed, blow air (0.39
kPa, 4.0 gf/cm2, 0.06 psi) into the vent port, and
check that air flows from the air inlet port.
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
A92446
(2)
Vent Port
Air Inlet Port
Air
While holding the air inlet port closed, blow air (0.39
kPa, 4.0 gf/cm2, 0.06 psi) into the vent port, and
check that air flows from the purge port.
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
Purge Port
A92447
(3)
Vent Port
Vacuum
Air Inlet Port
While holding the air inlet port closed, apply vacuum
(3.43 kPa, 25.7 gf/cm2, 1.01 psi) to the vent port,
and check that air is sucked in from the purge port.
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
Purge Port
A92448
Purge Port
Vent Port
Vacuum
Air Inlet Port
A92449
A
Vacuum
B
Vent Port
(c)
Check the air tightness.
(1) While holding the vent and air inlet ports closed, apply vacuum (3.43 kPa, 25.7 gf/cm2, 1.01 psi) to the
purge port, and check that the vacuum is maintained for 1 minute.
HINT:
In order to maintain air tightness, the check should be performed while holding the CCV terminal port closed.
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
(d) Check the diaphragm.
(1) Remove the air hose between ports A and B.
(2) While holding the vent, purge and air inlet ports
closed, apply vacuum (1.42 kPa, 11 mmHg, 0.42
in.Hg) into port A, and check that air is sucked in
from port B.
Purge Port
Air Inlet Port
A92450
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2465
12-8
EMISSION CONTROL
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
(3)
A
Vacuum
Vent Port
-
Purge Port
Air Inlet Port
While holding the vent, purge and air inlet ports
closed, apply vacuum (1.42 kPa, 11 mmHg, 0.42
in.Hg) into port A, and measure how long it takes for
vacuum to drop.
Vacuum drop time: 10 seconds or more
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
(4) Reinstall the air hose between ports A and B.
A92451
(e)
Check pump module operation.
(1) Check that air flows from port A to ports B and C.
If the result is not as specified, replace the pump module.
C
A
B
Air
A92453
(2) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(3) Check that the valve is closed.
If the result is not as specified, replace the pump module.
Valve
Closed
Battery
A92454
(4) Check that air does not flow from port A to port B.
(5) Check that air flows from port A to port C.
If the result is not as specified, replace the pump module.
C
B
Air
Battery
A
No Air
A92455
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2466
12-9
EMISSION CONTROL
4.
Ohmmeter
(a)
26 to 30 Ω
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE ASSY FOR
EVAP
Measure the VSV resistance between the terminals.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
26 to 30 Ω at 20C (68F)
1 - Body ground
2 - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the VSV assy.
Ohmmeter
10 MΩ or Higher
A92675
(b)
Check VSV operation.
(1) Check that air does not flow from the port as shown
in the illustration.
If the result is not as specified, replace the VSV assy.
No Air
Air
A92676
(2) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(3) Check that air flows from the ports.
If the result is not as specified, replace the VSV assy.
Air
Battery
A92681
5.
(a)
+B
AF-
HT
AF+
INSPECT A/F SENSOR (BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
Measure the resistance between terminals 1 (HT) and 2
(+B).
Standard:
Condition
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
0.8 to 1.4 Ω
800C (1,472F)
1.8 to 3.2 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
A75325
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2467
12-10
EMISSION CONTROL
6.
+B
(a)
HT
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (BANK 1
SENSOR 2)
Measure the resistance between terminals 1 (HT) and 2
(+B).
Standard:
Condition
E1
OX
A82934
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
11 to 16 Ω
800C (1,472F)
23 to 32 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2468
12-3
EMISSION CONTROL
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
120E2-01
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
E1
INSPECT AIR-FUEL RATIO COMPENSATION SYSTEM
Measure the voltage between the terminals of the ECM
connectors.
Standard:
(a)
E7
E8
E6
E9
E5
A1A+
A1A-
A59588
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E8-23 (A1A+) - E9-1(E1)
Ignition switch ON
3.3 V
E8-31 (A1A-) - E9-1(E1)
Ignition switch ON
2.9 V
NOTICE:
Connect test leads to the connector’s backside. The connectors should not be disconnected from the ECM.
HINT:
Voltage between the terminals of the ECM is kept constant regardless of the voltage of the A/F sensor.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Select ”DATA MONITOR”. Then select ”A/FS B1 S1”, and
”O2S B1 S2” to display the monitors.
(d) Warm up the A/F sensor with the engine speed at 2,500
rpm for approximately 2 minutes.
(e)
Keep Engine Speed
Lean
Keep the engine speed at 2,500 rpm and confirm that the
display of ”A/FS B1 S1” is as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
(V)
Air-fuel
14.6
Ratio
3.3V
(f)
Rich
Time
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
A92668
The illustration may slightly differ from the display on the
hand-held tester.
Only the hand-held tester displays the waveform of the
A/F sensor.
Confirm that the display of ”O2S B1 S2” changes between
0 to 1 V with the engine speed at 2,500 rpm.
INSPECT FUEL CUT OFF/RESTART RPM
Increase the engine speed to at least 3,500 rpm.
Use a sound scope to check for the injector operating noise.
When the accelerator pedal is released, injector operating noise stops momentarily and then resumes.
Standard:
Item
Specified Condition
Fuel cut off rpm
2,500 rpm
Fuel injector restart rpm
1,400 rpm
If the result is not as specified, check for DTCs. If a DTC is present, follow the repair procedures according
to the DTC.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2461
12-4
EMISSION CONTROL
3.
B11449
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
VISUALLY INSPECT HOSES, CONNECTIONS AND
GASKETS
Check for cracks, leaks or damage.
(a)
HINT:
Removal or problems with the engine oil dipstick, oil filler cap,
PCV hose and other components may cause the engine to run
improperly. Disconnection, looseness or cracks in the parts of
the air induction system between the throttle body and cylinder
head will allow air suction and cause the engine to run improperly. Be sure to check the areas indicated by the arrow marks.
If necessary, replace any damaged parts.
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
INSPECT FUEL CUTOFF VALVE AND FILL CHECK
VALVE
Disconnect the vent line hose from the fuel tank (see page
12-1 1).
Connect the pressure gauge to the fuel tank.
Fill the fuel tank with fuel.
Apply pressure of 4 kPa (41 gf/cm2, 0.58 psi) to the vent
port of the fuel tank.
HINT:
It is necessary to check the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. When
the fuel tank is full, the float valve of the fill check valve is closed
and no air can pass through.
(e) Remove the fuel tank cap, and check that pressure drops.
If pressure does not drop, replace the fuel tank assembly.
(f)
Reconnect the vent line hose to the fuel tank.
Fuel Tank Cap
Vent Line Hose
A85597
5.
(a)
CHECK AIR INLET LINE
Disconnect the air inlet line hose from the charcoal canister.
(b) Check that air can flow freely into the air inlet line.
If air cannot flow freely into the air inlet line, repair or replace it.
(c) Reconnect the air inlet line hose to the charcoal canister.
Air Inlet Line Hose
Air
A92684
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2462
12-5
EMISSION CONTROL
6.
(a)
VC (+)
E2 (-)
E7
E8
E6
E5
E9
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT PUMP MODULE (PRESSURE SENSOR)
Measure the power source voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E7-18 (VC) - E7-28 (E2)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
If the voltage is not as specified, replace the ECM.
(b) Measure the power output of the ECM connectors.
(1) Remove the fuel tank cap.
Standard
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E5-21 (PPMP)
- E7-28 (E2)
Ignition switch ON
1.425 to 4.150 V
If the voltage is not as specified, replace the ECM.
(2) Install the fuel tank cap.
PPMP (+)
Pressure Sensor Specification
Malfunction Area
Output Voltage
4.900 V
4.150 V
Usable Range
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
0.450 V
60
kPa
110
kPa
Pressure
HINT:
Atmospheric Pressure at altitude: 0 is 101.3 kPa
A92658
A71562
A92687
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2463
12-1
EMISSION CONTROL
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
120BH-02
LOCATION
Ventilation Valve
ECM
VSV Assy for EVAP
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
A/F Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Pump Module
Charcoal Canister Filter
Charcoal Canister
Fuel Tank Cap
Fuel Tank Assy
A85596
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2459
12-2
EMISSION CONTROL
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
120E1-01
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
The emission control system is determined by the ECM based on signals from various sensors.
Carbon Filter
Air Cleaner
ECM
Charcoal Canister Filter
Pump Module
VSV Assy for EVAP
Charcoal Canister
Fuel Tank Cap
Fuel Tank
A92660
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2460
12-1 1
EMISSION CONTROL
-
CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
120E4-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY CENTER
Remove the 4 bolts and 2 compression springs.
Remove the exhaust pipe center from the 4 exhaust pipe
supports.
Remove the 2 gaskets from the exhaust pipe front and exhaust pipe center.
(a)
(b)
(a)
(a)
(b)
(b)
(a)
(b)
A92669
2.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR HEAT INSULATOR NO.3
Remove the 4 bolts and heat insulator.
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY
Disconnect the pump module connector.
Disconnect the fuel emission hose.
Disconnect the air inlet line hose.
A92664
A92685
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2469
12-12
EMISSION CONTROL
Push
Pinch
CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(d)
Disconnect the fuel tank vent hose.
(1) Push the connector deeply into the charcoal canister to release the locking tab.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
(e)
4.
(a)
Remove the 3 nuts and charcoal canister.
INSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY
Install the charcoal canister with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
5.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR HEAT INSULATOR NO.3
Install the heat insulator with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 4.9 N⋅m (50 kgf⋅cm, 43 in.⋅lbf)
6.
(a)
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY CENTER
Install the exhaust pipe center to the 4 exhaust pipe supports.
Install a new gasket and the pipe center to the pipe front
with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 56 N⋅m (571 kgf⋅cm, 41 ft⋅lbf)
A
Pinch
-
A
A92665
A92457
A92664
(b)
(c)
A77857
Using a vernier caliper, measure the free length of the
compression spring.
Minimum length:
40.5 mm (1.594 in.) for center to tail
If the free length is less than minimum, replace the compression
spring.
(d) Install a new gasket and the pipe center to the pipe tail
with the 2 bolts and 2 compression springs.
Torque: 48 N⋅m (489 kgf⋅cm, 35 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2470
12-13
EMISSION CONTROL
-
CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
7.
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
If gas is leaking, tighten the areas necessary to stop the leak.
If damaged, replace it.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2471
12-14
EMISSION CONTROL
-
VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY (2AZ-FE)
VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY (2AZ-FE)
120BQ-04
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY
Disconnect the ventilation hose from the ventilation valve.
Remove the ventilation valve.
2.
(a)
Adhesive
A88710
(b)
INSTALL VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY
Install the ventilation valve.
(1) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(2) Install the ventilation valve.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (193 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the ventilation hose to the ventilation valve.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2472
12-23
EMISSION CONTROL
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
120BP-06
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY
Install a clean hose to the ventilation valve.
Check ventilation valve operation.
(1) Blow air into the cylinder head side, and check that
air passes through easily.
CAUTION:
Do not suck air through the valve. Petroleum substances
inside the valve are harmful.
Cylinder Head
Side
Clean Hose
A59511
(2)
Blow air into the intake manifold side, and check
that air passes through with difficulty.
If the result is not as specified, replace the ventilation valve.
(c) Remove the hose from the ventilation valve.
Intake Manifold
Side
Clean Hose
A59512
2.
(a)
INSPECT FUEL TANK CAP ASSY
Visually check if the cap and/or gasket are deformed or
damaged.
If necessary, repair or replace the cap and/or gasket.
Gasket
A92657
3.
(a)
INSPECT CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY
Visually check the charcoal canister for cracks or damage.
If cracks or damage is found, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
A81030
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2481
12-24
EMISSION CONTROL
Air
Vent Port
Air Inlet Port
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
(b)
Check the charcoal canister operation.
(1) While holding the purge port closed, blow air (0.39
kPa, 4.0 gf/cm2, 0.06 psi) into the vent port, and
check that air flows from the air inlet port.
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
Purge Port
A81031
Vent Port
(2)
While holding the air inlet port closed, blow air (0.39
kPa, 4.0 gf/cm2, 0.06 psi) into the vent port, and
check that air flows from the purge port.
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
Air
Air Inlet Port
Purge Port
A81032
(3)
While holding the air inlet port closed, apply vacuum
(3.43 kPa, 25.7 gf/cm2, 1.01 psi) to the vent port,
and check that air is sucked in from the purge port.
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
Vacuum
Vent Port
Air Inlet Port
Purge Port
Purge Port
A81033
(c)
Vacuum
Vent Port
Air Inlet Port
A92672
Vent Port
A
Vacuum
B
Purge Port
Check air tightness.
(1) While holding the vent and air inlet ports closed, apply vacuum (3.43 kPa, 25.7 gf/cm2, 1.01 psi) to the
purge port, and check that the vacuum is maintained for 1 minute.
HINT:
In order to maintain air tightness, the check should be performed while holding the CCV terminal port closed.
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
(d) Check the diaphragm.
(1) Remove the air hose between ports A and B.
(2) While holding the vent, purge and air inlet ports
closed, apply vacuum (1.42 kPa, 11 mmHg, 0.42
in.Hg) into port A, and check that air is sucked in
from port B.
Air Inlet Port
A81035
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2482
12-25
EMISSION CONTROL
A
Vacuum
Vent Port
Purge Port
Air Inlet Port
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
(3)
While holding the vent, purge and air inlet ports
closed, apply vacuum (1.42 kPa, 11 mmHg, 0.42
in.Hg) into port A, and measure how long it takes for
vacuum to drop.
Vacuum drop time: 10 seconds or more
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
(4) Reinstall the air hose between ports A and B.
A81036
(e)
Ohmmeter
Measure the VSV resistance for CCV between the terminals.
Standard:
Condition
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
25 to 30 Ω
100C (212F)
32 to 40 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister.
A74866
(f)
Check VSV operation for CCV.
(1) Check that air flows from port A to ports B and C.
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
C
B
Air
A
A74867
(2) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(3) Check that the valve is closed.
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
Battery
Valve
C
Closed
A74868
No Air
(4) Check that air does not flow from port A to port B.
(5) Check that air flows from port A to port C.
If the result is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister
assy.
B
Battery
Air
A
A74869
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2483
12-26
EMISSION CONTROL
4.
Ohmmeter
(a)
26 to 30 Ω
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE ASSY FOR
EVAP
Measure the VSV resistance.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
26 to 30 Ω at 20C (68F)
1 - Body ground
2 - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the VSV assy.
Ohmmeter
10 MΩ or Higher
A92675
(b)
Check VSV operation.
(1) Check that air does not flow from the port as shown
in the illustration.
If the result is not as specified, replace the VSV assy.
No Air
Air
A92676
(2)
(3)
Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
Check that air flows from the port as shown in the
illustration.
If the result is not as specified, replace the VSV assy.
Air
Battery
A92681
5.
(a)
+B
AF-
HT
AF+
INSPECT A/F SENSOR (BANK 1, 2 SENSOR 1)
Measure the resistance between terminals 1 (HT) and 2
(+B) and 1 (HT) and 4 (AF-).
Standard:
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
20°C (68°F)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω
1 (HT) - 4 (AF-)
-
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
A75325
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2484
12-27
EMISSION CONTROL
6.
+B
HT
(a)
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (BANK 1
SENSOR 2)
Measure the resistance between terminals 1 (HT) and 2
(+B).
Standard:
Condition
E1
OX
A82934
(a)
HT
20C (68F)
11 to 16 Ω
800C (1,472F)
23 to 32 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
7.
+B
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (BANK 2
SENSOR 2)
Measure the resistance between terminals 1 (HT) and 2
(+B).
Standard:
Condition
E1
OX
A80122
Specified Condition
Specified Condition
20C (68F)
11 to 16 Ω
800C (1,472F)
23 to 32 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2485
12-17
EMISSION CONTROL
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
120E6-02
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
E1
INSPECT AIR-FUEL RATIO COMPENSATION SYSTEM
Measure the voltage between the terminals of the ECM
connectors.
Standard:
(a)
E7
E8
E6
E9 A2A+
A2A-
E5
A1A+
A1A-
A59588
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E8-22 (A1A+) - E9-1(E1)
Ignition switch ON
3.3 V
E8-30 (A1A-) - E9-1(E1)
Ignition switch ON
3.0 V
E8-23 (A2A+) - E9-1(E1)
Ignition switch ON
3.3 V
E8-31 (A2A-) - E9-1(E1)
Ignition switch ON
3.0 V
NOTICE:
Connect test leads to the connector’s backside. The connectors should not be disconnected from the ECM.
HINT:
Voltage between the terminals of the ECM is kept constant regardless of the voltage of the A/F sensor.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Select ”DATA MONITOR”. Then select ”A/FS B1 S1”,
”A/FS B2 S1” and ”O2S B1 S2” to display the monitors.
(d) Warm up the A/F sensor with the engine speed at 2,500
rpm for approximately 2 minutes.
(e)
Keep Engine Speed
Lean
HINT:
(V)
Air-fuel
14.6
Ratio
3.3V
Rich
Time
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Keep the engine speed at 2,500 rpm and confirm that the
displays of ”A/FS B1 S1” and ”A/FS B2 S1” are as shown
in the illustration.
A92668
(f)
The illustration may differ slightly from the display on the
hand held tester.
Only the hand-held tester displays the waveform of the
A/F sensor.
Confirm that the display of ”O2S B1 S2” changes between
0 to 1 V with the engine speed at 2,500 rpm.
INSPECT FUEL CUT OFF/RESTART RPM
Increase the engine speed to at least 3,500 rpm.
Use a sound scope to check for the injector operating noise.
When the accelerator pedal is released, injector operating noise stops momentarily and then resumes.
Standard:
Item
Specified Condition
Fuel cut off rpm
2,500 rpm
Fuel injector restart rpm
1,400 rpm
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2475
12-18
EMISSION CONTROL
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
If the result is not as specified, check for DTCs. If a DTC is present, follow the repair procedures according
to the DTC.
3.
P12931
(a)
HINT:
Removal or problems with the engine oil dipstick, oil filler cap,
PCV hose and other components may cause the engine to run
improperly. Disconnection, looseness or cracks in the parts of
the air induction system between the throttle body and cylinder
head will allow air suction and cause the engine to run improperly. Be sure to check the areas indicated by the arrow marks.
If necessary, replace any damage parts.
4.
Vacuum Gauge
(a)
(b)
B06544
Using hand-held tester:
INSPECT EVAP SYSTEM LINE
Warm up and stop the engine.
(1) Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature.
Install a vacuum gauge (EVAP control system test equipment vacuum gauge) to the EVAP service port on the
purge line.
A75352
Hand-Held Tester
DLC3
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
Turn the hand-held tester main switch ON.
Use the ACTIVE TEST mode on the hand-held tester to
operate the VSV for EVAP.
(g)
Check the vacuum while the engine is idling.
Standard:
Maintain at 0.368 to 19.713 in.Hg (5 to 268 in.Aq) for
over 5 seconds.
A80020
Vacuum Gauge
B06545
VISUALLY INSPECT HOSES, CONNECTIONS AND
GASKETS
Check for cracks, leaks or damage.
A75353
HINT:
If the vacuum does not change, the hose connecting the VSV
to the service port has come loose or is blocked, or the VSV is
malfunctioning.
(h) Stop the engine.
(i)
Disconnect the hand-held tester from the DLC3.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2476
12-19
EMISSION CONTROL
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
(j)
Disconnect the vacuum gauge from the EVAP service
port on the purge line.
(k)
Connect a pressure gauge to the EVAP service port on
the purge line.
Pressure Gauge
A72589
Hand-held Tester
DLC3
A80020
(l)
(m)
(n)
(o)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Turn the hand-held tester main switch ON.
Use the ACTIVE TEST mode on the hand-held tester to
operate the VSV for CCV.
NOTICE:
In step (m), the ignition switch should be ON, but the engine
should not be running.
HINT:
If the check is not completed within 10 minutes, the VSV for
CCV will be reset and close automatically.
(p)
Pressure Gauge
Pressure
A75354
B06546
Fuel Tank Cap
Check the pressure.
(1) Add 13.5 to 15.5 in.Aq of pressure from the EVAP
service port.
Standard:
2 minutes after the pressure is added, the gauge
should still read over 7.7 to 8.8 in.Aq.
HINT:
If you cannot add pressure, the hose connecting the VSV for
EVAP canister fuel tank has become disconnected or the VSV
is open.
(2) Check if the pressure decreases when the fuel tank
cap is removed while adding pressure.
HINT:
If the pressure does not decrease when the fuel tank cap is removed, the hose connecting the service port to the fuel tank is
blocked.
(q) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(r)
Disconnect the hand-held tester from the DLC3.
A92656
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2477
12-20
EMISSION CONTROL
5.
Vacuum Gauge
(a)
(b)
B06544
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
Not using hand-held tester:
INSPECT EVAP SYSTEM LINE
Warm up and stop the engine.
(1) Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature.
Install a vacuum gauge (EVAP control system test equipment vacuum gauge) to the EVAP service port on the
purge line.
A75352
(c)
(d)
(e)
Disconnect the VSV connector for EVAP.
Connect the battery’s positive (+) and negative (-) leads
to the VSV terminals for EVAP.
Start the engine.
Battery
A75314
(f)
Vacuum Gauge
B06545
A75353
HINT:
If the vacuum does not change, the hose connecting the VSV
to the service port has come loose or is blocked, or the VSV is
malfunctioning.
(g) Stop the engine.
(h) Disconnect the battery’s positive (+) and negative (-)
leads from the VSV terminals for EVAP.
(i)
Reconnect the VSV connector for EVAP.
(j)
Disconnect the vacuum gauge from the EVAP service
port on the purge line.
(k)
Pressure Gauge
Check the vacuum while the engine is idling.
Standard:
Maintain at 0.368 to 19.713 in.Hg (5 to 268 in.Aq) for
over 5 seconds.
Connect a pressure gauge to the EVAP service port on
the purge line.
A72589
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2478
12-21
EMISSION CONTROL
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
(l)
(m)
Disconnect the VSV connector for CCV.
Connect the battery’s positive (+) and negative (-) leads
to the VSV terminals for CCV.
NOTICE:
Incorrect electrode connection causes damage to the VSV.
Pay due attention when connecting the lead wire.
Battery
A80147
(n)
Pressure Gauge
Pressure
A75354
B06546
Fuel Tank Cap
A92656
Check the pressure.
(1) Add 13.5 to 15.5 in.Aq of pressure from the EVAP
service port.
Standard:
2 minutes after the pressure is added, the gauge
should still read over 7.7 to 8.8 in.Aq.
HINT:
If you cannot add pressure, the hose connecting the VSV for
EVAP canister fuel tank has become disconnected or the VSV
is open.
(2) Check if the pressure decreases when the fuel tank
cap is removed while adding pressure.
HINT:
If the pressure does not decrease when the fuel tank cap is removed, the hose connecting the service port to the fuel tank is
blocked.
(o) Disconnect the battery’s positive (+) and negative (-)
leads from the VSV terminals for CCV.
(p) Reconnect the VSV connector for CCV.
(q) Disconnect the pressure gauge from the EVAP service
port on the purge line.
6.
Vent Line Hose
A66040
CHECK AIR TIGHTNESS IN FUEL TANK AND FILLER
PIPE
(a) Disconnect the vent line hose from the fuel tank (see page
12-28 ).
(b) Connect the pressure gauge to the fuel tank.
(c) Apply pressure to the fuel tank to create an internal pressure of 4 kPa (41 gf/cm2, 0.58 psi).
(d) Check that the internal pressure of the fuel tank is maintained for 1 minute.
(e) Check the connected portions of each hose and pipe.
(f)
Check the installed parts on the fuel tank.
If malfunctions, damage or other problems are found, replace
the fuel tank and filler pipe.
(g) Reconnect the vent line hose to the fuel tank.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2479
12-22
EMISSION CONTROL
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT FUEL CUTOFF VALVE AND FILL CHECK
VALVE
Disconnect the vent line hose from the fuel tank (see page
12-28 ).
Connect the pressure gauge to the fuel tank.
Fill the fuel tank with fuel.
Apply pressure of 4 kPa (41 gf/cm2, 0.58 psi) to the vent
port of the fuel tank.
HINT:
It is necessary to check the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. When
the fuel tank is full, the float valve of the fill check valve is closed
and no air can pass through.
(e) Remove the fuel tank cap, and check that pressure drops.
If pressure does not drop, replace the fuel tank assembly.
(f)
Reconnect the vent line hose to the fuel tank.
Fuel Tank Cap
Vent Line Hose
A85597
8.
(a)
CHECK AIR INLET LINE
Disconnect the air inlet line hose from the charcoal canister.
(b) Check that air can flow freely into the air inlet line.
If air cannot flow freely into the air inlet line, repair or replace it.
(c) Reconnect the air inlet line hose to the charcoal canister.
Air
Air Inlet Line Hose
A66042
9.
(a)
VC (+)
E2 (-)
E7
E8
E6
E5
E9
INSPECT VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
Measure the power source voltage of the ECM connectors.
Standard
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E7-18 (VC) - E7-28 (E2)
Ignition switch ON
4.5 to 5.5 V
If the voltage is not as specified, replace the ECM.
(b) Measure the power output of the ECM connectors.
(1) Remove the fuel tank cap.
Standard
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E5-21 (PTNK)
- E7-28 (E2)
Ignition switch ON
3.0 to 3.6 V
If the voltage is not as specified, replace the ECM.
(2) Reinstall the fuel tank cap.
PTNK (+)
A92658
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2480
12-15
EMISSION CONTROL
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
120BM-02
LOCATION
Ventilation Valve
VSV Assy No. 1
Vacuum Surge Tank
EVAP Service Port
A/F Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
A/F Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
VSV for CCV
Charcoal Canister Filter
Charcoal Canister
Fuel Tank Cap
Fuel Tank Assy
A85594
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2473
12-16
EMISSION CONTROL
-
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
120E5-01
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
The emission control system is determined by the ECM based on signals from various sensors.
Refueling Valve
Vapor Pressure Sensor
ECM
Restrictor Passage
Air Cleaner
Carbon Filter
Charcoal Canister
Purge Valve
Fuel Tank
EVAP
Service Port
Purge Line
Fresh Air Line
Charcoal Canister Filter
VSV for CCV
A88556
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2474
12-28
EMISSION CONTROL
-
CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
120E7-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY CENTER
Remove the 4 bolts and 4 compression springs.
Remove the exhaust pipe center from the 4 exhaust pipe
supports.
Remove the 2 gaskets from the exhaust pipe front No. 3
and the exhaust pipe center.
(b)
(a)
(a)
(b)
(a)
(b)
(a)
(b)
A81209
2.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR HEAT INSULATOR NO.3
Remove the 4 bolts and heat insulator.
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY
Disconnect the VSV connector for CCV.
Disconnect the fuel emission hose.
Disconnect the air inlet line hose.
A92664
(a)
(b)
(c)
A92686
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2486
12-29
EMISSION CONTROL
Push
Pinch
CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(d)
Disconnect the fuel tank vent hose.
(1) Push the connector deeply into the charcoal canister assy to release the locking tab.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
(e)
Remove the 3 nuts, and then remove the charcoal canister.
INSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY
Install the charcoal canister with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
A
Pinch
-
A
A92665
4.
(a)
A81213
5.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR HEAT INSULATOR NO.3
Install the heat insulator with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 4.9 N⋅m (50 kgf⋅cm, 43 in.⋅lbf)
A92664
6.
(a)
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY CENTER
Using a vernier caliper, measure the free length of the
compression spring.
Minimum length:
41.5 mm (1.634 in.) for center to front No. 3
40.5 mm (1.594 in.) for center to tail
If the free length is less than minimum, replace the compression
spring.
A77857
New Gasket
(b)
(c)
(d)
Install 2 new gaskets to the exhaust pipe front No. 3 and
the exhaust pipe center as shown in the illustration.
Install the exhaust pipe center to the 4 exhaust pipe supports.
Install the 4 compression springs and 4 bolts.
Torque: 48 N⋅m (489 kgf⋅cm, 35 ft⋅lbf)
A78440
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2487
12-30
EMISSION CONTROL
-
CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
7.
CHECK EXHAUST LEAKAGE
If gas is leaking, tighten the areas necessary to stop the leak.
If damaged, replace it.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2488
12-31
EMISSION CONTROL
-
VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE)
VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE)
120BR-04
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY
Disconnect the ventilation hose from the ventilation valve.
Remove the ventilation valve.
2.
(a)
Adhesive
A92670
(b)
INSTALL VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY
Install the ventilation valve.
(1) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(2) Install the ventilation valve.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (193 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the ventilation hose to the ventilation valve.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2489
13-2
INTAKE
-
INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
1308R-01
INSPECTION
Lever
Valve
Actuator Rod
A85563
1.
(a)
INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE ASSY NO.2
Apply 26.7 kPa (200 mmHg, 7.9 in.Hg) of vacuum to the
actuator. Check if the actuator rod pulls the lever and
causes the valve to rotate open, as shown in the illustration.
(b) One minute after applying the vacuum, check that the actuator rod does not return.
If the result is not as specified, replace the IAC valve assy No.
2.
2.
(a)
C
A
B
A85559
Ohmmeter
INSPECT AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
Cover port C with your finger and blow air into port B.
Check that air flows out of port A.
(b) Cover port C with your finger and blow air into port A.
Check that air does not flow out of port B.
(c) Cover ports A and C with your fingers, and apply 60 kPa
(450 mmHg, 18 in.Hg) of vacuum to port B. Check that
there is no change in the vacuum after one minute.
If the result is not as specified, replace the air cleaner cap.
3.
33 to 39 Ω
1
2
(a)
INSPECT VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE ASSY FOR
IAC VALVE NO. 2
Measure the VSV resistance.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
33 to 39 Ω at 20C (68F)
1 - Body ground
2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the VSV assy.
Ohmmeter 10 kΩ or higher
1
2
A85555
A85556
Body Ground
A85570
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2491
13-3
INTAKE
Air
-
INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
(b)
Check VSV operation.
(1) Check that air flows from port E to the filter.
If the result is not as specified, replace the VSV assy.
Filter
E
FI6393
(2) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(3) Check that air flows from port E to port F.
If the result is not as specified, replace the VSV assy.
Air
E
F
Battery
S04523
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2492
13-1
INTAKE
-
INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
1307N-02
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
Vacuum Gauge
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
A85554
INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL SYSTEM
Using a 3-way connector, connect a vacuum gauge to the
actuator hose.
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine.
On the hand-held tester, enter the ACTIVE TEST mode.
Standard:
Switch Condition
Vacuum
VSV ON
Approx. 27.6 kPa (200 mmHg, 7.9 in.Hg)
VSV OFF
0 kPa (0 mmHg, 0 in.Hg)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2490
13-4
INTAKE
-
INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE ASSY NO.2 (3MZ-FE)
INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE ASSY NO.2 (3MZ-FE)
1307P-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
Lever
(c)
REMOVE INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE ASSY NO.2
Remove the 3 bolts and nut.
Turn the lever to the closed position as shown in the illustration and pull out the IAC valve.
Remove the gasket from the intake air surge tank.
A81629
2.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE ASSY NO.2
Install a new gasket to the intake air surge tank.
Install the IAC valve with the 3 bolts and nut.
Torque: 10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2493
14-1
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
ENGINE (2AZ-FE)
ENGINE (2AZ-FE)
141P0-02
INSPECTION
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
INSPECT ENGINE OIL
INSPECT BATTERY
INSPECT AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUB-ASSY
INSPECT SPARK PLUG (See page 18-3 )
INCORRECT
CORRECT
A87787
Hand-held Tester
6.
INSPECT V-RIBBED BELT
HINT:
After installing the drive belt, check that it fits properly in
the ribbed grooves. Check with your hand to confirm that
the belt has not slipped out of the groove on the bottom
of the crank pulley.
”New belt” is a belt which has been used less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
”Used belt” is a belt which has been used on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
After installing a new belt, run the engine for approximately 5 minutes and then recheck the tension.
7.
INSPECT IGNITION TIMING
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b)
When using the hand-held tester:
Check the ignition timing.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Enter DATA LIST MODE on the hand-held tester.
Ignition timing: 8 to 12 BTDC @ idle
HINT:
Please refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for help
on selecting the DATA LIST.
DLC3
A80020
(c)
CG
DLC3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 1213141516
TC
A82779
When not using the hand-held tester:
Check the ignition timing.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals 13 (TC) and 4 (CG)
of the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
NOTICE:
Confirm the terminal numbers before connecting
them. Connection with a wrong terminal can damage
the engine.
Turn off all electrical systems before connecting the
terminals.
Perform this inspection after the cooling fan motor is
turned off.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2494
14-2
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(2)
(3)
A52004
Hand-held Tester
DLC3
A80020
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 1213141516
TAC
ENGINE (2AZ-FE)
Remove the cylinder head cover No. 2.
Pull out the wire harness as shown in the illustration.
Connect the clip of the timing light to the engine.
NOTICE:
Use a timing light which can detect the first signal.
After checking, be sure to tape the wire harness.
(4) Check the ignition timing at idle.
Ignition timing: 8 to 12 BTDC @ idle
NOTICE:
When checking the ignition timing, the transmission
should be in the neutral position.
HINT:
After engine rpm is kept at 1,000 to 1,300 rpm for 5 seconds,
check that it returns to idle speed.
(5) Remove the SST from the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(6) Check the ignition timing at idle.
Ignition timing: 5 to 15 BTDC @ idle
(7) Confirm that ignition timing moves to the advanced
angle side when the engine rpm is increased.
(8) Remove the timing light.
8.
INSPECT ENGINE IDLE SPEED
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b)
When using the hand-held tester:
Check the idle speed.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
HINT:
Please refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(2) Enter DATA LIST MODE on the hand-held tester.
Idle speed: 610 to 710 rpm
NOTICE:
When checking the idle speed, the transmission
should be in the neutral position.
Check idle speed with the cooling fan off.
Switch off all accessories and air conditioning before
connecting the hand-held tester.
(c)
DLC3
-
When not using the hand-held tester:
Check the idle speed.
(1) Using SST, connect tachometer tester probe to terminal 9 (TAC) of the DLC3.
(2) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed: 610 to 710 rpm
SST 09843-18030
A82779
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2495
14-3
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
ENGINE (2AZ-FE)
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
A01037
INSPECT COMPRESSION
Warm up and stop the engine.
Disconnect the injector connectors.
Remove the ignition coils.
Remove the spark plugs.
Check the cylinder compression pressure.
(1) Insert a compression gauge into the spark plug
hole.
(2) Fully open the throttle.
(3) While cranking the engine, measure the compression pressure.
Compression pressure:
1,360 kPa (13.9 kgf/cm2, 198 psi)
Minimum pressure: 0.98 MPa (10 kgf/cm2, 142 psi)
Difference between each cylinder:
100 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 14 psi)
NOTICE:
Always use a fully charged battery to obtain engine
speed of 250 rpm or more.
Check other cylinder’s compression pressure in the
same way.
This measurement must be done as quickly as possible.
(4) If the cylinder compression is low, pour a small
amount of engine oil into the cylinder through the
spark plug hole and inspect again.
HINT:
If adding oil increases the compression, the piston rings
and/or cylinder bore may be worn or damaged.
If pressure stays low, a valve may be stuck or seated improperly, or there may be leakage in the gasket.
10. INSPECT CO/HC
(a) Start the engine.
(b) Rev the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 180 seconds.
(c) Insert CO/HC meter testing probe at least 40 cm (1.3 ft) into the tailpipe during idling.
(d) Immediately check CO/HC concentration at idle and/or 2,500 rpm.
HINT:
Complete the measuring within 3 minutes.
Check regulations and restrictions in your area when performing 2 mode CO/HC concentration testing
(engine check at both idle speed and at 2,500 rpm).
(e) If the CO/HC concentration does not comply with regulations, troubleshoot in the order given below.
(1) Check A/F sensor operation (see page 12-3 ).
(2) See the table below for possible causes, and then inspect and repair.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2496
14-4
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CO
Normal
Low
High
HC
High
High
High
-
ENGINE (2AZ-FE)
Problems
Causes
Rough idle
1. Faulty ignitions:
Incorrect timing
Fouled, shorted or improperly gapped plugs
2. Incorrect valve clearance
3. Leaky intake and exhaust valves
4. Leaky cylinders
Rough idle
(fluctuating HC reading)
1. Vacuum leaks:
PCV hoses
Intake manifold
Throttle body
Brake booster line
2. Lean mixture causing misfire
Rough idle
(black smoke from exhaust)
1. Restricted air filter
2. Plugged PCV valve
3. Faulty SFI system:
Faulty pressure regulator
Defective ECT
Defective MAF meter
Faulty ECM
Faulty injectors
Faulty throttle position sensor
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2497
14-5
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (2AZ-FE)
FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (2AZ-FE)
141P1-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD FRONT RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
REMOVE ENGINE COVER SUB-ASSY NO.1
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD W/BRACKET (See page 14-24 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET NO.2 RH
8.
(a)
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
Slowly turn the belt tensioner clockwise for more than 3
seconds, and remove the drive belt by using SST.
SST 09843-18030
9.
(a)
INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT
Slowly turn the belt tensioner clockwise for more than 3
seconds, and install the drive belt by using SST.
SST 09249-63010
SST
A62240
SST
A62240
10.
11.
12.
13.
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET NO.2 RH
Torque: 52 N⋅m (531 kgf⋅cm, 38 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD W/BRACKET (See page 14-24 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
Torque: 64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2498
14-6
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
VALVE CLEARANCE (2AZ-FE)
VALVE CLEARANCE (2AZ-FE)
141P2-01
ADJUSTMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD FRONT RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE ENGINE COVER SUB-ASSY NO.1
REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSY
REMOVE SPARK PLUG
DISCONNECT VENTILATION HOSE
DISCONNECT VENTILATION HOSE NO.2
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY
Remove the bolt and disconnect the engine wire harness
clamp.
Remove the 8 bolts, 2 nuts, cylinder head cover and gasket.
A94204
10.
(a)
Timing Marks
(b)
11.
HINT:
Inspect and adjust the valve clearance when the engine is cold.
Timing Marks
Groove
SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align its groove with timing
mark 0 of the timing chain cover.
Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing gear
and sprocket are aligned with the timing marks of the
bearing cap No. 1 and No. 2 as shown in the illustration.
INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
A53043
(a)
No. 1 Cylinder TDC/Compression
IN
Check only the valve indicated on the left.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the valve lifter and camshaft.
(2) Record valve clearance measurements that are out
of the specified range. These measurements will be
used later to determine the size of the adjustment
shim to be installed.
EX
A52469
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2499
14-7
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
VALVE CLEARANCE (2AZ-FE)
Valve clearance (Cold):
No. 4 Cylinder TDC/Compression
Paint Mark
Timing Mark
Timing Mark
Groove
Exhaust
0.30 to 0.40 mm (0.012 to 0.016 in.)
Turn the crankshaft clockwise 1 revolution (360) and set
the No.4 cylinder to TDC/compression.
(c)
Check only the valve indicated on the left.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the valve lifter and camshaft.
(2) Record valve clearance measurements that are out
of the specified range. These measurements will be
used later to determine the size of the adjustment
shim to be installed.
Valve clearance (Cold):
A52470
Paint Mark
Specified Condition
0.19 to 0.29 mm (0.008 to 0.011 in.)
(b)
IN
EX
Item
Intake
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
0.19 to 0.29 mm (0.008 to 0.011 in.)
Exhaust
0.30 to 0.40 mm (0.012 to 0.016 in.)
12. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
NOTICE:
Be sure not to turn the crankshaft without the chain tensioner.
(a) Turn the crankshaft clockwise 1 revolution (360) and set
the No. 1 cylinder to the TDC/compression.
(b) Place paint marks on the timing chain and camshaft timing gear sprocket.
A52471
(c)
Remove the 2 bolts and chain tensioner.
A13325
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2500
14-8
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Loosen
-
VALVE CLEARANCE (2AZ-FE)
(d)
Remove the No. 2 camshaft.
(1) Fix the camshaft with a wrench and then loosen the
sprocket bolt.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the valve lifter.
Fix
A52454
1
3
5
4
2
(2)
Uniformly loosen and remove the No. 2 camshaft’s
10 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in the
illustration. Then remove the 5 bearing caps.
(3)
Raise the No. 2 camshaft and remove it. Then remove the sprocket bolt.
Remove the camshaft timing sprocket and the timing chain from the No. 2 camshaft.
Remove the camshaft timing sprocket from the timing chain.
A32636
(4)
(5)
A87614
1
3
5
4
(e)
2
Remove the camshaft.
(1) Uniformly loosen and remove the camshaft’s 10
bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration. Then remove the 5 bearing caps.
(2) Remove the camshaft.
A36526
(f)
Tie the timing chain with a string.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop anything inside the timing chain cover.
(g) Remove the valve lifters.
A52474
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2501
14-9
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(h)
-
VALVE CLEARANCE (2AZ-FE)
Adjust the valve clearance.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the
removed lifter.
(2) Calculate the thickness of a new lifter so that the
valve clearance comes within the specified value.
A
A01082
Thickness of new lifter
B
Thickness of used lifter
C
Measured valve clearance
Valve clearance:
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
A = B + (C - 0.24 mm (0.0094 in.))
Exhaust
A = B + (C - 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.))
EXAMPLE: (Intake)
Measured valve clearance = 0.44 mm (0.0173 in.)
0.44 mm (0.0173 in.) - 0.24 mm (0.0094 in.) = 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
(Measured - Specification = Excess clearance)
Used shim measurement = 5.30 mm (0.2087 in.)
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.) + 5.30 mm (0.2087 in.) = 5.50 mm (0.2165 in.)
(Excess clearance + Used shim = Ideal new shim)
Closest new shim = 5.50 mm (0.2165 in.) = Shim No. ”50”
(3) Select a new lifter with a thickness as close as possible to the calculated values.
HINT:
Lifters are available in 35 sizes in increments of 0.020 mm
(0.0008 in.), from 5.060 mm (0.1992 in.) to 5.740 mm
(0.2260 in.).
Refer to valve lifter selection chart on the following 2
pages.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2502
14-10
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Valve Lifter Selection Chart (Intake)
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
Author:
Date:
A77296
2503
Intake valve clearance (Cold):
0.19 to 0.29 mm (0.008 to 0.011 in.)
EXAMPLE:
The 5.250 mm (0.2067 in.) lifter is installed, and the measured
clearance is 0.400 mm (0.0157 in.). Replace the 5.250 mm
(0.2067 in.) lifter with a new No. 42 lifter.
mm (in.)
Thickness
Lifter
No.
Thickness
30
5.300 (0.2087)
54
5.540 (0.2181)
5.080 (0.2000)
32
5.320 (0.2094)
56
5.560 (0.2189)
10
5.100 (0.2008)
34
5.340 (0.2102)
58
5.580 (0.2197)
12
5.120 (0.2016)
36
5.360 (0.2110)
60
5.600 (0.2205)
14
5.140 (0.2024)
38
5.380 (0.2118)
62
5.620 (0.2213)
16
5.160 (0.2031)
40
5.400 (0.2126)
64
5.640 (0.2220)
18
5.180 (0.2039)
42
5.420 (0.2134)
66
5.660 (0.2228)
20
5.200 (0.2047)
44
5.440 (0.2142)
68
5.680 (0.2236)
22
5.220 (0.2055)
46
5.460 (0.2150)
70
5.700 (0.2244)
24
5.240 (0.2063)
48
5.480 (0.2157)
72
5.720 (0.2252)
26
5.260 (0.2071)
50
5.500 (0.2165)
74
5.740 (0.2260)
28
5.280 (0.2079)
52
5.520 (0.2173)
Lifter
No.
Thickness
Lifter
No.
06
5.060 (0.1992)
08
VALVE CLEARANCE (2AZ-FE)
New Lifter Thickness
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Valve Lifter Selection Chart (Exhaust)
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
Author:
Date:
mm (in.)
Lifter
Thickness
No.
Thickness
06
5.060 (0.1992)
30 5.300 (0.2087)
54 5.540 (0.2181)
08
5.080 (0.2000)
32 5.320 (0.2094)
56 5.560 (0.2189)
10
5.100 (0.2008)
34 5.340 (0.2102)
58 5.580 (0.2197)
12
5.120 (0.2016)
36 5.360 (0.2110)
60 5.600 (0.2205)
14
5.140 (0.2024)
38 5.380 (0.2118)
62 5.620 (0.2213)
16
5.160 (0.2031)
40 5.400 (0.2126)
64 5.640 (0.2220)
18
5.180 (0.2039)
42 5.420 (0.2134)
66
20
5.200 (0.2047)
44 5.440 (0.2142)
68 5.680 (0.2236)
22
5.220 (0.2055)
46 5.460 (0.2150)
70 5.700 (0.2244)
24
5.240 (0.2063)
48 5.480 (0.2157)
72 5.720 (0.2252)
26
5.260 (0.2071)
50 5.500 (0.2165)
74 5.740 (0.2260)
28
5.280 (0.2079)
52 5.520 (0.2173)
No.
No.
Thickness
5.660 (0.2228)
14-1 1
A77297
2504
Exhaust valve clearance (Cold):
0.30 to 0.40 mm (0.012 to 0.016 in.)
EXAMPLE:
The 5.340 mm (0.2102 in.) lifter is installed, and the measured
clearance is 0.440 mm (0.0173 in.). Replace the 5.340 mm
(0.2102 in.) lifter with a new No. 44 lifter.
Lifter
VALVE CLEARANCE (2AZ-FE)
New lifter thickness
Lifter
14-12
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(i)
Paint Mark
-
VALVE CLEARANCE (2AZ-FE)
Install the camshaft.
(1) Install the timing chain on the camshaft timing gear,
with the paint mark aligned with the timing marks on
the camshaft timing gear.
Timing Marks
A52456
5
3
1
Bearing Cap No. 1
2
(2)
Examine the front marks and numbers of the 5 bearing caps and install them. Then install the 10 bearing cap bolts. Uniformly tighten the bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque:
30 N⋅m (301 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf) for bearing cap No. 1
9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf) for bearing cap No. 3
4
Bearing Cap No. 3
A52457
(j)
Paint Mark
Timing Mark
Install the No. 2 camshaft.
(1) Put the No. 2 camshaft on the cylinder head with the
paint mark of the chain aligned with the timing mark
on the camshaft timing sprocket.
A53011
(2)
Raise the No. 2 camshaft and temporarily tighten
the sprocket bolt.
A52473
Bearing Cap No. 2 Bearing Cap No. 3
5
3
1
2
4
(3)
Examine the front marks and numbers of the 5 bearing caps and install them. Then install the 10 bearing cap bolts. Uniformly tighten the bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque:
30 N⋅m (301 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf) for bearing cap No. 2
9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf) for bearing cap No. 3
A52458
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2505
14-13
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Tighten
-
VALVE CLEARANCE (2AZ-FE)
(4)
Fix the camshaft with a wrench, then tighten the
sprocket bolt.
Torque: 54 N⋅m (551 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the valve lifter.
Fix
A52459
(k)
Check that the timing chain paint marks are aligned with
the camshaft timing sprocket timing mark and the camshaft timing gear timing mark. Also check the alignment
of the pulley groove and chain cover timing mark.
(l)
Install the chain tensioner.
(1) Release the ratchet pawl, fully push in the plunger
and apply the hook to the pin so that the plunger
cannot spring out.
7 Links
Paint Mark
Paint Mark
Timing Marks
Timing Mark
Groove
A52460
Raise
Push
Pin
Hook
A52461
(2)
Install a new gasket and the chain tensioner with the
2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
When installing the tensioner, set the hook again if the
hook releases the plunger.
Engine
Front
A52462
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2506
14-14
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(3)
-
VALVE CLEARANCE (2AZ-FE)
Turn the crankshaft counterclockwise, and disconnect the plunger knock pin from the hook.
Disconnect
Turn
Pin
Hook
A93972
(4)
13.
(a)
Turn the crankshaft clockwise, and check that the
slipper is pushed by the plunger.
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY
Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
Plunger
Push
Turn
A93973
(b)
Seal Packing
A53051
A
A
A
A
B
A
14.
15.
16.
17.
Nut
B
A
Apply seal packing to 2 locations as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Install the cylinder head cover within 5 minutes after
applying seal packing.
Do not start the engine for at least 2 hours after installing the cylinder head cover.
(c)
Install the cylinder head cover with the 8 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque:
11 N⋅m (112 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf) for nut
11 N⋅m (112 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
14 N⋅m (143 kgf⋅cm, 10 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
Nut
A61989
INSTALL SPARK PLUG
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSY
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-6 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2507
14-15
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
141P3-03
COMPONENTS
Front Fender Apron Seal RH
Engine Cover Sub-assy No. 1
Fan and Generator V Belt
52 (530, 38)
21 (214, 15)
Generator Assy
×3
Compressor and
Magnetic Clutch
5.0 (51, 44 in.⋅lbf)
25 (255, 18)
Front Fender Splash
Shield Front RH
Air Cleaner
Assy
Battery
Engine Under Cover No. 1
×8
Front Fender Splash
Shield Front LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm,ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
A90964
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2508
14-16
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
64 (653, 47)
64 (653, 47)
Engine Moving Control
Rod W/Bracket
52 (530, 38)
Engine Moving Control Rod Bracket No. 2
64 (653, 47)
Front Stabilizer Link Assy LH
Engine Mounting Stay No. 2 RH
Propeller Shaft Assy (4WD)
35 (357, 26)
74 (755, 55)
×2
Steering Intermediate
Shaft Sub-assy
×4
×2
74 (755, 55)
Floor Shift Transmission
Control Cable Assy
Tie Rod Assy LH
74 (755, 55)
15 (153, 11)
49 (500, 36)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Front Suspension Member
Brace Rear RH
Speed Sensor Front LH
Front Suspension
Member Brace Rear LH
Frame Side
Plate RH
Front Axle Hub LH Nut
×2
127 (1295, 94)
294 (3,000, 217)
Front Suspension Arm Sub-assy
Lower No. 1
32 (326, 24)
Frame Side
Plate LH 32 (326, 24)
86 (877, 63)
Exhaust Pipe
assy Front
86 (877, 63)
56 (571, 41)
Exhaust Pipe Gasket
Exhaust Pipe Gasket
48 (489, 35)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A90965
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2509
14-17
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Vane Pump Assy
Drive Shaft Bearing Bracket (2WD)
64 (653, 47)
×2
43 (438, 31)
×3
54 (551, 40)
64 (653, 47)
×3
95 (969, 70)
75 (765, 55)
34 (347, 25)
×2
Engine Mounting
Bracket RH
×3
Engine Mounting Bracket RR (4WD)
64 (653, 47)
×3
95 (696, 70)
Stabilizer Bar Front (4WD)
19 (194, 14)
19 (194, 14)
64 (653, 47)
87 (897, 64)
70 (714, 52)
Rack & Pinion Power Steering
Gear Assy (4WD)
Front Frame Assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
A90967
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2510
14-18
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Front Drive Shalt Assy RH
Drive Shaft Bearing
Bracket Hole Snap Ring
64 (653, 47)
64 (653, 47)
Drive Shaft Bearing Bracket
Flywheel Housing Under Cover
Drive Plate
Spacer Front
44 (449, 32)
Engine Wire
Drive Plate and Ring
Gear Sub-assy
98 (1,000, 72)
×8
41 (418, 30)
64 (653, 47)
×6
Drive Plate
Spacer Rear
46 (469, 34)
Starter Assy
39 (398, 29)
Front Drive Shaft
LH Hole Snap Ring
Front Drive Shaft Assy LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A94363
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2511
14-19
ENGINE MECHANICAL
30 (306, 22)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Intake Manifold Sub-assy
Ignition Coil Assy
×3
Gasket
30 (306, 22)
Engine Wire
Intake Manifold Insulator No. 1
Ventilation Hose No. 1
Ventilation Hose No. 2
Manifold Converter
Insulator No. 1
V-Ribbed Belt Tensioner Assy
12 (122, 9)
12 (122, 9.0)
59.5 (607, 44)
12 (122, 9.0)
Gasket
37 (337, 27)
×5
Exhaust Manifold Converter Sub-assy
Manifold Stay
44 (449, 32)
Manifold Stay No. 2
44 (449, 32)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A90966
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2512
14-20
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Engine Cover Sub-assy No. 1
14 (143,10)
×2
11 (112, 8)
Ventilation Valve
11 (112, 8)
×6
19 (194, 14)
×2
Cylinder Head Cover Sub-assy
Camshaft Position
Sensor
Cylinder Head Cover Gasket
Spark Plug
19 (194, 14)
×4
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Water Pump Assy
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Water Pump Pulley
×4
26 (265, 19)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
×2
Oil Filter Union
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
30 (306, 22)
180 (1835, 133)
Oil Filter Sub-assy
Crankshaft Pulley
Oil Pan Sub-assy
Gasket
Oil Pan Drain Plug
25 (255, 18)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
× 12
×2
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
A90971
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2513
14-21
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Chain Sub-asy
Chain Tensioner
Slipper
Chain Vibration Damper No. 1
Crankshaft Timing
Gear or Sprocket
No.2 Chain Sub-assy
19 (194, 14)
×2
Crankshaft Position
Sensor Plate No.1
Spring
Camshaft Timing Gear Sprocket
Chain Tensioner Plate
30 (306, 22)
×2
Gasket
12 (122, 9.0)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Oil pump Assy
Timing Chain Guide
×3
19 (194, 14)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
×2
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Chain Tensioner Assy No. 1
×2
Gasket
43 (438, 32)
V-Ribbed belt
Tensioner Assy
×4
60 (612, 44)
Timing Chain or
Belt Cover Sub-assy
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Timing Gear Case or
Timing Chain Case oil Seal
×8
21 (210, 16)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A92864
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2514
14-22
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
× 16
30 (306, 22)
×4
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 3
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 1
Camshaft Bearing No. 1
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 3
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 2
Camshaft (Intake)
Camshaft Timing Gear Assy
No. 2 Camshaft (Exhaust)
See page (14-41 )
1st: 79 (806, 58)
2nd: Turn 90
54 (551, 40)
54 (551, 40)
× 10
Camshaft Timing Gear or Sprocket
Cylinder Head Sub-assy
Camshaft Bearing No. 2
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Camshaft Timing
Oil Control Valve
O-Ring
Cylinder Head Gasket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A92010
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2515
14-23
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Engine Rear Oil Seal
Plug
30 (306, 22)
Gasket
Oil Control Valve Filter
for Camshaft Timing
O-ring
Stiffening Crankcase Assy
33 (337, 24)
×5
×6
Balanceshaft No. 1
33 (337, 24)
Balanceshaft No. 2
Balanceshaft Bearing No. 1
Balanceshaft Housing
See page (14-41 )
1st: 22 (220, 15)
2nd: Turn 90
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
×8
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A91573
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2516
14-41
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
141P5-01
OVERHAUL
1.
(a)
REMOVE OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY
Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228-06501
SST
A36541
2.
(a)
3.
4.
5.
REMOVE OIL FILTER UNION
Using a 12 mm hexagon wrench, remove the union.
REMOVE OIL FILLER CAP SUB-ASSY
REMOVE VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY
REMOVE SPARK PLUG
6.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY
(a) Remove the 8 bolts, 2 nuts, and cylinder head cover.
A94204
7.
8.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER GASKET
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
9.
(a)
Timing Marks
(b)
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
Turn the crankshaft pulley and align its groove with timing
mark 0 of the timing chain cover.
Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing
sprockets are aligned with the timing marks of the No. 1
bearing cap, as shown in the illustration.
Timing Marks
Groove
A53043
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2534
14-42
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c)
SST
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Remove the crankshaft pulley.
(1) Using SST, fix the pulley and loosen the bolt.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
A36684
(2) Using SST, remove the bolt and pulley.
SST 09950- 50013 (09951- 05010, 09952- 05010,
09953-05020, 09954-05021)
SST
A36685
10. REMOVE CHAIN TENSIONER ASSY NO.1
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, chain tensioner and gasket.
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft without the chain tensioner.
A13325
11.
(a)
REMOVE WATER PUMP PULLEY
Using SST, remove the water pump pulley.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00700)
12.
(a)
REMOVE WATER PUMP ASSY
Remove the 4 bolts, 2 nuts, bracket and water pump.
SST
A36335
Bracket
A53037
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2535
14-43
ENGINE MECHANICAL
13.
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
REMOVE OIL PAN DRAIN PLUG
14.
(a)
REMOVE OIL PAN SUB-ASSY
Remove the 12 bolts and 2 nuts.
B12056
(b)
Insert the blade of SST between the crankcase and oil
pan. Cut off the applied sealer and remove the oil pan.
SST 09032-00100
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surface of the cylinder block and oil pan.
A00019
15.
REMOVE TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER
SUB-ASSY
(a) Remove the 14 bolts and 2 nuts.
(b) Remove the timing chain cover by prying between the timing chain cover and cylinder head or cylinder block with
a screwdriver.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the timing
chain cover, cylinder block and cylinder head.
A77251
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2536
14-44
ENGINE MECHANICAL
16.
(a)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the oil seal.
A32626
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PLATE NO.1
TIMING CHAIN GUIDE
CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER NO.1
CHAIN SUB-ASSY
CRANKSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR SPROCKET
90
23.
(a)
REMOVE NO.2 CHAIN SUB-ASSY
Turn the crankshaft counterclockwise 90, and align the
adjusting hole of the oil pump driven sprocket with the
groove of the oil pump.
(b)
Put a bar (φ 4 mm (0.16 in.)) in the adjusting hole of the
oil pump driven sprocket to temporarily lock the sprocket
in position. then remove the nut.
Groove
A52508
Groove
A52509
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2537
14-45
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(c)
(d)
Remove the bolt, chain tensioner plate and spring.
Remove the oil pump sprocket gear,driven sprocket and
chain.
24.
(a)
REMOVE OIL PUMP ASSY
Remove the 3 bolts, oil pump and gasket.
25.
(a)
REMOVE NO.2 CAMSHAFT (EXHAUST)
Uniformly loosen and remove the No. 2 camshaft (exhaust)’s 10 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in
the illustration. Then remove the 5 bearings.
Remove the camshaft.
B11415
A32684
(b)
1
3
5
4
2
1
3
5
4
2
A36530
26.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Uniformly loosen and remove the camshaft (intake)’s 10
bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration. Then remove the 5 bearings.
Remove the camshaft.
A36531
27.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT BEARING NO.1
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2538
14-46
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
28.
(a)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR SPROCKET
Fix the camshaft with a vise and remove the camshaft timing sprocket.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
A32167
29.
(a)
Advanced
Angle Side
(b)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
Fix the camshaft with a vise, and make sure that the camshaft timing gear does not move.
Cover all the oil ports with vinyl tape except the advanced
angle side, as shown in the illustration.
A90848
Using an air gun, apply about 150 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm2, 21
psi) of air pressure to the port on the advanced angle side.
CAUTION:
Some oil spraying will occur. Contain the spray with a shop
rag.
HINT:
This operation releases the lock pin for the extreme retarded
angle lock.
(d) Under the condition above, check that the camshaft timing gear can be turned by hand to the advanced angle
side (counterclockwise), the direction of the arrow shown
in the illustration.
Standard: Must turn
HINT:
The camshaft timing gear will turn to the advanced angle side
without applying force by hand depending on the force of the
air pressure applied. Also, if applying pressure to the oil path is
difficult as a result of air leakage from the port, the lock-pin may
be difficult to release.
(c)
A31032
(e) Remove the fringe bolt from the camshaft timing gear.
NOTICE:
Be sure not to remove the other 4 bolts.
If planning to reuse the camshaft timing gear, release
the straight pin lock first, and then install the gear.
A32639
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2539
14-47
ENGINE MECHANICAL
30.
31.
33.
34.
35.
(a)
36.
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT BEARING NO.2
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
3
7
9
6
1
5
10
8
2
4
A94200
32.
(a)
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSY
Using a 10 mm bi-hexagon wrench, uniformly loosen the
10 bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 10 cylinder head bolts and plate washers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the washers into the cylinder
head.
Head warpage or cracking could result from removing bolts in an incorrect order.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
REMOVE CYLINDER BLOCK WATER DRAIN COCK SUB-ASSY
REMOVE OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
Using a 6 mm socket hexagon wrench, remove the plug and filter.
REMOVE W/HEAD TAPER SCREW PLUG NO.1
37. INSPECT BALANCESHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while
moving the balanceshaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.050 to 0.090 mm (0.0020 to 0.0035 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance: 0.090 mm (0.0035 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
balanceshaft housing and bearings. If necessary, replace the
balance shaft.
A53071
38.
(a)
4
1
8
5
6
7
2
3
A93962
INSPECT BALANCESHAFT OIL CLEARANCE
Uniformly loosen and remove the 8 bolts in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the balanceshaft housing and crankcase.
HINT:
Keep the lower bearing and balanceshaft housing together.
(b) Lift out the No. 1 and No. 2 balanceshafts.
HINT:
Keep the upper bearing with the crankcase.
(c) Clean each bearing and journal.
(d) Check each bearing and journal for pitting and scratches.
If a bearing or journal is damaged, replace the bearings. If necessary, replace the balance shaft.
(e) Place the No. 1 and No. 2 balanceshafts on the crankcase.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2540
14-48
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(f)
(g)
Plastigage
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Lay a strip of Plastigage across each journal, and install
the balanceshaft housing.
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the heads of the balanceshaft housing bolts.
A90849
(h)
5
8
1
4
3
2
7
6
Uniformly tighten the 8 bolts in the sequence shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 22 N⋅m (220 kgf⋅cm, 16 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
The balanceshaft housing bolts are tightened in 2 progressive
steps.
A93962
90
(i)
Paint
Mark
(j)
(k)
Engine Front
Mark the front side of each balanceshaft housing bolt
head with paint.
Retighten the bolts 90 as shown in the illustration.
Check that the paint marks are now at a 90 angle to the
front.
A50671
(l)
(m)
Remove the balanceshaft housing, and measure the
Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.004 to 0.031 mm (0.0002 to 0.0012 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.031 mm (0.0012 in.)
Completely remove the Plastigage after the inspection.
A13392
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2541
14-49
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the bearing. If necessary, replace the balanceshaft.
If using a standard bearing, replace it with one of the same number.
Balanceshaft housing journal bore diameter:
(n)
No. 2
Shaft FR
No. 2
Shaft RR
26.000 to 26.006 mm (1.0236 to 1.0239 in.)
Mark 2
26.007 to 26.012 mm (1.0239 to 1.0241 in.)
Mark 3
26.013 to 26.018 mm (1.0241 to 1.0243 in.)
Balanceshaft journal diameter:
22.985 to 23.000 mm (0.9049 to 0.9055 in.)
Standard bearing center wall thickness:
No. 1
Shaft RR
No. 1
Shaft FR
Mark 1
Mark 1
1.486 to 1.489 mm (0.0585 to 0.0586 in.)
Mark 2
1.489 to 1.492 mm (0.0586 to 0.0587 in.)
Mark 3
1.492 to 1.495 mm (0.0587 to 0.0589 in.)
Completely remove the Plastigage after the inspection.
Mark
A53040
39.
40.
REMOVE BALANCESHAFT
REMOVE BALANCESHAFT BEARING NO. 1
41. REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
(a) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(b) Using a screwdriver with its tip taped, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
After the removal, check the crankshaft for damage. If it is
damaged, smooth the surface with 400-grit sandpaper.
Cut Position
A13493
1
5
2
6
9
11
8
4
10
7
3
42.
(a)
A94192
REMOVE STIFFENING CRANKCASE ASSY
Uniformly loosen and remove the 11 bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the crankcase by prying the
portions between the crankcase and cylinder block.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the crankcase and cylinder block.
(c) Remove the O-ring from the cylinder block.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2542
14-50
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
43.
(a)
(b)
A53035
INSPECT OIL PUMP DRIVE SPROCKET
Wrap the chain around the drive gear.
Using a vernier caliper, measure the sprocket diameter
with the chain.
Minimum sprocket diameter (w/chain):
48.2 mm (1.898 in.)
NOTICE:
The vernier caliper must contact the chain rollers for the
measurement.
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the chain and
sprocket.
44.
(a)
(b)
A53036
A53035
INSPECT OIL PUMP DRIVEN SPROCKET
Wrap the chain around the drive shaft gear.
Using a vernier caliper, measure the sprocket diameter
with the chain.
Minimum gear diameter (w/chain): 48.2 mm (1.898 in.)
NOTICE:
The vernier caliper must contact the chain rollers for the
measurement.
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the chain and
sprocket.
45. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR
SPROCKET
(a) Wrap the chain around the timing gear.
(b) Using a vernier caliper, measure the timing gear diameter
with the chain.
Minimum gear diameter (w/ chain): 51.6 mm (2.031 in.)
NOTICE:
The vernier caliper must contact the chain rollers for the
measurement.
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the chain and
timing gear.
46.
(a)
INSPECT CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
Measure the tensioner slipper wear.
Maximum wear: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the wear is greater than the maximum, replace the tensioner
slipper.
A33838
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2543
14-51
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
47.
(a)
INSPECT CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER NO.1
Measure the vibration damper wear.
Maximum wear: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the wear is greater than the maximum, replace the vibration
damper.
A36686
48.
(a)
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD SET BOLT
Using a vernier caliper, measure the length of the head
bolts from the seat to the end.
Standard bolt length:
161.3 to 162.7 mm (6.3503 to 6.4055 in.)
Maximum bolt length: 164.2 mm (6.4646 in.)
If the length is greater than the maximum, replace the bolt.
Specified Bolt Length
A94201
49.
(a)
Raise
Move
(b)
Lock
INSPECT CHAIN TENSIONER ASSY NO.1
Check that the plunger moves smoothly when the ratchet
pawl is raised.
Release the ratchet pawl and check that the plunger is
locked in place by the ratchet pawl and does not move
when pushed with your finger.
A53049
50.
(a)
115.4 mm
15 Links
A57478
INSPECT CHAIN SUB-ASSY
Using a vernier caliper, measure the length of 15 links with
the chain fully stretched.
Maximum chain elongation: 115.4 mm (4.543 in.)
NOTICE:
Make the same measurements pulling at 3 or more places
selected at random. Average the measurements.
If the elongation is greater than the maximum, replace the
chain.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2544
14-52
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
51.
(a)
(b)
A30206
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR SPROCKET
Wrap the chain around the timing sprocket.
Using a vernier caliper, measure the timing sprocket diameter with the chain.
Minimum sprocket diameter (w/chain):
97.3 mm (3.831 in.)
NOTICE:
The vernier caliper must contact the chain rollers for the
measurement.
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the chain and
timing gear.
52.
(a)
INSPECT CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Check the camshaft for runout.
(1) Place the camshaft on V-blocks.
(2) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout at
the center journal.
Maximum circle runout: 0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than the maximum, replace the
camshaft.
EM1628
(b)
Using a micrometer, measure the cam lobe height.
Standard cam lobe height:
46.495 to 46.595 mm (1.8305 to 1.8344 in.)
Minimum cam lobe height: 46.385 mm (1.8262 in.)
If the cam lobe height is less than the minimum, replace the
camshaft.
A36687
(c)
Using a micrometer, measure the journal diameter.
No. 1 journal diameter:
35.971 to 35.985 mm (1.4162 to 1.4167 in.)
Other journal diameter:
22.959 to 22.975 mm (0.9039 to 0.9045 in.)
If the journal diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance.
A36688
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2545
14-53
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
53.
(a)
INSPECT NO.2 CAMSHAFT (EXHAUST)
Check the camshaft for runout.
(1) Place the camshaft on V-blocks.
(2) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout at
the center journal.
Maximum circle runout: 0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than the maximum, replace the
camshaft.
EM1628
(b)
Using a micrometer, measure the cam lobe height.
Standard cam lobe height:
45.983 to 46.083 mm (1.8104 to 1.8143 in.)
Minimum cam lobe height: 45.873 mm (1.8060 in.)
If the cam lobe height is less than the minimum, replace the
camshaft.
A36687
(c)
Using a micrometer, measure the journal diameter.
No. 1 journal diameter:
35.971 to 35.985 mm (1.4162 to 1.4167 in.)
Other journal diameter:
22.959 to 22.975 mm (0.9039 to 0.9045 in.)
If the journal diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance.
A36688
54.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL BALANCESHAFT BEARING NO.1
Install the bearings in the crankcase and balanceshaft housing.
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the bearings.
55.
(a)
Matchmarks
(b)
INSTALL BALANCESHAFT NO. 1 AND NO. 2
Rotate the driven gear No. 1 of balanceshaft No. 1 for the
rotating direction until it hits the stopper.
Confirm that the matchmarks on driven gear No. 1 and
No. 2 are matched.
Rotating Direction
A90850
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2546
14-54
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c)
Timing Marks
(d)
(e)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Align the timing marks of the No. 1 and No. 2 balanceshafts as shown in the illustration.
Place the No. 1 and No. 2 balance shafts on the crank
case.
Apply a light coat of engine oil under the heads of the balance shaft housing bolts.
A13508
(f)
5
8
1
4
3
2
7
6
Uniformly tighten the 8 bolts in the sequence shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 22 N⋅m (224 kgf⋅cm, 16 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
The balanceshaft housing bolts are tightened in 2 progressive
steps.
A93962
90
(g)
Paint
Mark
(h)
(i)
Engine Front
Mark the front side of each balance shaft housing bolt
head with paint.
Retighten the bolts by 90 as shown in the illustration.
Check that the painted marks are now at a 90 angle to
the front.
A50671
Seal Packing
Seal width: 2.5 to 3.0 mm
A
C
D
B
B
56.
(a)
INSTALL STIFFENING CRANKCASE ASSY
Apply seal packing in a continuous bead (seal width: 2.5
to 3.0 mm (0.098 to 0.118 in.)) to the places shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Install the crankcase within 3 minutes after applying
seal packing.
Do not start the engine for at least 2 hours after installing.
C,D
A
A,B: 7.5 mm (0.295 in.)
C,D: 4.0 mm (0.1575 in.)
A94193
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2547
14-55
ENGINE MECHANICAL
O-ring
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(b)
Place a new O-ring on the cylinder block, as shown in the
illustration.
(c)
With the No. 1 crank pin of the crankshaft placed at 6
o’clock, install the No. 1 and No. 2 balanceshaft and the
adjusting hole as shown in the illustration.
(d)
Uniformly tighten the 11 bolts in the sequence shown in
the illustration.
Torque: 33 N⋅m (337 kgf⋅cm, 24 ft⋅lbf)
(e)
Confirm that the timing marks of the balanceshafts are
matched when the key groove is placed at 6 o’clock, as
shown in the illustration.
A53026
No. 1
Crank Pin
Timing Marks
A91021
11
7
10
6
3
1
4
8
2
5
9
A94192
Timing Marks
Key
A94194
SST
A32658
57. INSTALL ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
(a) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
NOTICE:
Keep the lip off the foreign materials.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, evenly tap the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST 09223-15030, 09950-70010 (09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Wipe off extra grease on the crankshaft.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2548
14-56
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
58.
(a)
INSTALL W/HEAD TAPER SCREW PLUG NO.1
Apply adhesive to the threads of the plug and install it.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
Torque: 26 N⋅m (265 kgf⋅cm, 19 ft⋅lbf)
59.
INSTALL OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER FOR
CAMSHAFT TIMING
Check that no foreign substance is on the mesh part of the
filter.
Using a 6 mm socket hexagon wrench, install a new gasket and the oil control valve filter with the screw plug.
Torque: 30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
A36850
(a)
(b)
Mesh Part
A53039
60.
(a)
45
INSTALL CYLINDER BLOCK WATER DRAIN COCK
SUB-ASSY
Install the water drain cock within the range shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
45
A36835
Lot No.
61.
(a)
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
Place a new gasket on the cylinder block surface with the
Lot No. stamp upward.
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from contact surface.
Be careful of the installation direction.
To avoid damage to the gasket, place the cylinder
head on the gasket carefully.
INTAKE
Engine
Front
EXHAUST
A90968
62. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSY
HINT:
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 progressive steps.
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the heads of the cylinder head bolts.
(b) Install the 10 bolts and plate washers to the cylinder head.
NOTICE:
Do not drop the washers into the cylinder head.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2549
14-57
ENGINE MECHANICAL
8
4
2
5
10
6
1
3
9
7
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(c)
Using a 10 mm bi-hexagon wrench, uniformly tighten the
10 bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 79 N⋅m (806 kgf⋅cm, 58 ft⋅lbf)
(d)
(e)
Mark the front side of each cylinder head bolt with paint.
Retighten the cylinder head bolts by 90 in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
Check that the painted marks are now at a 90 angle to
the front.
A94195
90
(f)
Engine
Front
Paint Mark
A00976
63.
A53074
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
64. INSTALL CAMSHAFT BEARING NO.2
(a) Install the bearing to the camshaft.
NOTICE:
Clean the contact surfaces of the bearing and the cylinder
head. the surfaces should be free of dust and oils.
A13383
65.
(a)
Straight
Pin
Key
Groove
A31033
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
Put the camshaft timing gear and the camshaft together
with the straight pin and key groove.
(b) Turn the camshaft timing gear (as shown in the illustration) while pushing it lightly against the camshaft. Push
further at the position where the pin enters the groove.
CAUTION:
Be sure not to turn the camshaft timing gear to the retarded
angle side (to the right angle).
(c) Check that there is no clearance between the gear’s
fringe and the camshaft.
(d) Tighten the fringe bolt with the camshaft timing gear fixed.
Torque: 54 N⋅m (551 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2550
14-58
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(e)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Check that the camshaft timing gear can move to the retarded angle side (the right direction) and is locked at the
extreme retarded angle position.
HINT:
66.
(a)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the heads of the bolt.
Length of sprocket bolt excluding bolt head: 40 mm (1.57
in.)
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR SPROCKET
Fix the camshaft with a vise, and install the camshaft No.
2 timing gear.
Torque: 54 N⋅m (551 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
A32167
67.
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the heads of the bolt.
Length of sprocket bolt excluding bolt head: 25 mm (0.98
in.)
INSTALL CAMSHAFT BEARING NO.1
5 3
1
2
68.
(a)
4
Bearing Cap No. 1 Bearing Cap No. 3 A92649
Bearing Cap No. 2
5
3
Bearing Cap No. 3
1
2
4
INSTALL CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Examine the front marks and numbers of the 5 bearing
caps and install them. Then install the 10 bearing cap
bolts. Uniformly tighten the bolts in the sequence shown
in the illustration.
Torque:
30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf) for bearing cap No. 1
9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf) for bearing cap No. 3
NOTICE:
Tighten the bolts after deciding the position for the
thrust direction of the camshaft by the bearing cap
No. 1.
Install the camshaft with its timing mark of the camshaft timing gear on top.
69.
(a)
INSTALL NO.2 CAMSHAFT (EXHAUST)
Examine the front marks and numbers of the 5 bearing
caps and install them. Then install the 10 bearing cap
bolts. Uniformly tighten the bolts in the sequence shown
in the illustration.
Torque:
30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf) for bearing cap No. 2
9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf) for bearing cap No. 3
A94196
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2551
14-59
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
NOTICE:
Tighten the bolts after deciding the position for the
thrust direction of the camshaft by the bearing cap
No. 2.
Install the camshaft with its timing mark of the camshaft timing gear on top.
70.
(a)
INSTALL OIL PUMP ASSY
Install a new gasket and oil pump with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
71.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL NO.2 CHAIN SUB-ASSY
Set the crankshaft key into the left horizontal position.
Turn the cutout of the drive shaft to the top.
(c)
Align the mark links (yellow colored links) with the timing
marks of the sprocket as shown in the illustration.
Insert the sprocket with chain to the crankshaft and oil
pump shaft.
Temporarily tighten the oil pump driven sprocket with the
nut.
A32684
B11424
Mark Link
Timing Mark
(d)
(e)
Timing Mark
Mark Link
A94198
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2552
14-60
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Chain Tensioner Plate
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(f)
Insert the damper spring into the adjusting hole, and
install the chain tensioner plate by the bolt.
Torque: 12 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9.0 ft⋅lbf)
(g)
Align the adjusting hole of the sprocket with the groove of
the oil pump.
Put a bar (φ 4 mm (0.16 in.)) into the adjusting hole of the
sprocket to temporarily lock the sprocket in position.
Install the nut.
Torque: 30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
Bolt
Spring
A90851
(h)
Groove
A52512
(i)
90
Rotate the crankshaft clockwise 90, and align the crankshaft key with the top.
A36525
72.
73.
(a)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR SPROCKET
INSTALL CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER NO.1
Install the chain vibration damper with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2553
14-61
ENGINE MECHANICAL
74.
(a)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL CHAIN SUB-ASSY
Set the No. 1 cylinder to TDC/compression.
(1) Align the timing marks of the camshaft timing gear/
sprocket and bearing caps (No. 1 and No. 2).
Timing Marks
Timing Marks
A53018
(2)
Using the crankshaft pulley bolt, turn the crankshaft
and set the set key on the crankshaft upward.
A52505
(b)
Align the mark link (blue or orange colored link) with the
timing mark of the crankshaft timing sprocket.
(c)
Using SST, tap in the sprocket.
SST 09309-37010
Timing Mark
Mark Link
A52523
SST
A13337
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2554
14-62
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d)
Mark Links
Timing Mark
Timing Marks
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Align the mark links (gold or yellow colored links) with the
timing marks of the camshaft timing gear and camshaft
timing sprocket. Then install the chain.
A52513
75.
76.
INSTALL CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL TIMING CHAIN GUIDE
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
77.
(a)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PLATE
NO.1
Install the sensor plate with the F mark facing forward.
A53064
78.
SST
A13767
B
A
Seal
Cylinder Head
Packing
Gasket
Cylinder
Head
A
Seal Packing
Cylinder
Seal
Block
Packing
Seal Width: 2.0 mm
B
Seal Packing
INSTALL TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING CHAIN
CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, tap in a new oil seal until its surface is flush
with the timing chain cover edge.
SST 09223-22010
(b) Apply a light coat of MP grease to the lip of the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Keep the gap between the timing chain cover edge and the
oil seal free of foreign matter.
79. INSTALL TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Install the chain cover within 3 minutes after applying
seal packing.
Do not start the engine for at least 2 hours after installing.
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful
not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the timing
chain cover, cylinder head and cylinder block.
(b) Apply seal packing in a continuous bead (seal width: 2.0
mm (0.079 in.)) as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
A90970
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2555
14-63
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(c)
Apply seal packing in a continuous bead (seal width: 3.0
to 4.0 mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)) as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
(d)
Install the timing chain cover with the 14 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque:
9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf) for bolt A
21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
43N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf) for bolt C
9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf) for nut
Install the stud bolt to the drive belt tensioner.
Torque: 10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf)
4.0 mm
(0.16 in.)
A
A
2.5 mm
(0.098 in.)
A
Seal Width:
3.0 to 4.0 mm
A
A94199
C
Nut
Nut
C
C
C
B
(e)
C
A
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
A77251
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2556
14-64
ENGINE MECHANICAL
6.0 mm
(0.236 in.)
Seal Width:
3.0 to 4.0 mm
Seal Packing
A94202
9
11
1
8
12
7
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
80. INSTALL OIL PAN SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Install the oil pan within 3 minutes after applying seal
packing.
Do not start the engine for at least 2 hours after installing.
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful
not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the cylinder
block and oil pan.
(b) Apply seal packing in a continuous bead (seal width: 3.0
to 4.0 mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)) as shown in the illustration,
and install the oil pan.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
(c)
10
-
Uniformly tighten the 12 bolts and 2 nuts in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
13
6
14
5
81.
(a)
4
3
2
A64641
INSTALL OIL PAN DRAIN PLUG
Install a new gasket and the drain plug.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
82.
(a)
(b)
0.5 to 1.0 mm
(0.020 to 0.039 in.)
Seal Width:
2.2 to 2.5 mm
A94203
INSTALL WATER PUMP ASSY
Clean the contact surface of the cylinder block.
Apply seal packing in a continuous bead (seal width: 2.2
to 2.5 mm (0.087 to 0.098 in.)) to the outside edge of the
water pump.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00100 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Install the water pump within 5 minutes after applying
seal packing.
Do not start the engine for at least 2 hours after installing.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2557
14-65
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(c)
Install the water pump with the 4 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten the outside bolts and nuts with the clamp.
B12052
83.
(a)
INSTALL WATER PUMP PULLEY
Using SST, install the water pump pulley with the 4 bolts.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00700)
Torque: 26 N⋅m (265 kgf⋅cm, 19 ft⋅lbf)
84.
(a)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Install the sensor with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Confirm that the wire harness of the sensor is placed as
shown in the illustration.
SST
A36335
Wire Harness
(b)
Clamp
Rib
A52071
85.
(a)
(b)
SST
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
Install the pulley.
Using SST,tighten the bolt.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
Torque: 180 N⋅m (1,835 kgf⋅cm, 133 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the bolt threads and the area
beneath the bolt head that come in contact with the washer.
A36684
86.
(a)
Raise
INSTALL CHAIN TENSIONER ASSY NO.1
Release the ratchet pawl, fully push in the plunger and apply the hook to the pin so that the plunger cannot spring
out.
Push
Pin
Hook
A52461
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2558
14-66
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(b)
Install a new gasket and the chain tensioner with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
If the hook is released while inserting, apply the hook
again, and insert the chain tensioner.
Engine
Front
A52462
(c)
Turn the crankshaft counterclockwise and check that the
plunger knock pin is disconnected from the hook.
(d)
Turn the crankshaft clockwise and check that the slipper
is pushed by the plunger.
Disconnect
Turn
Pin
Hook
A93972
Plunger
Push
Turn
87.
88.
89.
(a)
A93973
INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE (See page 14-6 )
ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE (See page 14-6 )
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER GASKET
Install the gasket to the cylinder head cover.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2559
14-67
ENGINE MECHANICAL
90.
(a)
Seal Packing
A
A94205
A
A
B
A
91.
92.
(a)
93.
94.
(a)
Nut
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY
Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
(b)
Seal Packing
A
-
B
Apply seal packing to the 2 locations shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Install the cylinder head cover within 5 minutes after
applying seal packing.
Do not apply engine oil for at least 2 hours after installing.
(c)
Install the cylinder head cover with the 8 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque:
11 N⋅m (112 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf) for nut
11 N⋅m (112 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
14 N⋅m (143 kgf⋅cm, 10 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
Nut
A
A94204
INSTALL SPARK PLUG
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY
Apply adhesive on the threads of the ventilation valve.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
Adhesive: Part No. 08833-00070 THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
INSTALL OIL FILLER CAP SUB-ASSY
INSTALL OIL FILTER UNION
Using a 12 mm hexagon wrench, install the oil filter union.
Torque: 30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
95. INSTALL OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY
(a) Check and clean the oil filter installation surface.
(b) Apply clean engine oil to the gasket of a new oil filter.
(c) Lightly screw the oil filter into place, and tighten it until the
gasket contacts the seat.
(d) Using SST, tighten it an additional 3/4 turn.
SST 09228-06501
SST
A36541
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2560
14-24
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
141P4-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
(a)
(b)
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
WORK FOR PREVENTING GASOLINE FROM SPILLING OUT (See page 11-1 )
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD FRONT RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD FRONTR LH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
DRAIN COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the drain plug and gasket. Drain automatic transaxle fluid.
Install a new gasket and the drain plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
DRAIN TRANSFER OIL (4WD TYPE)
REMOVE BATTERY
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSY
DISCONNECT RADIATOR HOSE INLET
DISCONNECT RADIATOR HOSE OUTLET
DISCONNECT OIL COOLER INLET HOSE
DISCONNECT OIL COOLER OUTLET HOSE
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
17.
(a)
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
W/BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and engine moving control rod.
A92861
18.
19.
20.
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET NO.2 RH
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page 14-5 )
DISCONNECT VANE PUMP OIL RESERVOIR ASSY
21.
(a)
DISCONNECT RETURN TUBE SUB-ASSY
Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the return tube.
A52493
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2517
14-25
ENGINE MECHANICAL
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
DISCONNECT
DISCONNECT
DISCONNECT
DISCONNECT
DISCONNECT
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
UNION TO CHECK VALVE HOSE
TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY (See page 40-34 )
HEATER INLET WATER HOSE
HEATER OUTLET WATER HOSE
FUEL TUBE SUB-ASSY (See page 11-1 )
27. DISCONNECT ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE
(a) Disconnect the engine wire from the ECM and J/B.
(b) Disconnect the engine wire from the engine room J/B.
(1) Remove the nut fixing the wire harness.
(2) Using a screwdriver, unlock the engine room J/B.
Disconnect the engine wire by pulling it upward.
(3) Disconnect the connectors.
(4) Remove the body ground.
A53014
28.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (See page 15-2 )
29.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE PROPELLER SHAFT (4WD TYPE)
Place the matchmarks on both of the flanges.
Remove the 4 nuts, 4 bolts and 4 washers.
(c)
Insert SST after removing the propeller shaft.
SST 09325-20010
Matchmark
A52514
SST
A53068
30. REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
(a) Using a 6 mm socket hexagon wrench, fix the stud bolt.
(b) Remove the nut and disconnect the stabilizer link.
31. REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2518
14-26
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
32.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB RH NUT
Using SST and a hammer, strike the lock nut covering to
remove it.
SST
SST 09930-00010
NOTICE:
Set the drive shaft’s groove so that it faces up. Then
use the SST and a hammer.
Remove the covering from the lock nut completely or
the screw of the drive shaft may be damaged.
C65981
Do not sharpen the tip of the SST.
(b) Using a 30 mm socket wrench, remove the lock nut.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
33.
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
34. DISCONNECT SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the speed sensor from the steering knuckle.
NOTICE:
Keep the speed sensor tip and connection free from a foreign matter.
35. DISCONNECT SPEED SENSOR FRONT RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
36.
(a)
(b)
DISCONNECT TIE ROD ASSY LH
Remove the cotter pin and castle nut.
Using SST, disconnect the tie rod end from the steering
knuckle.
SST 09628-6201 1
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover of the ball joint.
SST
C65311
37. DISCONNECT TIE ROD ASSY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
38.
(a)
DISCONNECT FRONT SUSPENSION ARM
SUB-ASSY LOWER NO.1 LH
Fix the crankshaft and remove the 6 setting bolts.
C65935
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2519
14-27
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
39. DISCONNECT FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY LOWER NO.1 RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
40.
(a)
REMOVE DRIVE PLATE & TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SETTING BOLT
Fix the crankshaft and remove the 6 setting bolts.
A62253
41.
(a)
DISCONNECT STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
SUB-ASSY
Loosen the sliding yoke bolt.
A52332
(b)
Matchmark
(c)
Place matchmarks on the intermediate shaft and control
valve shaft.
Remove the bolt and the steering intermediate shaft.
A52331
(d)
To prevent the steering wheel from rotating, fix the wheel
with the seat belt.
NOTICE:
If the steering wheel is not fixed, the spiral cable will be
damaged.
A52334
42. DISCONNECT COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
HINT:
Hung up the hoses instead of detaching.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2520
14-28
ENGINE MECHANICAL
B
B
B
B
A
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
43.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE
Set the engine lifter.
Remove the 6 bolts and frame side rail plate RH and LH.
(c)
Remove the 6 bolts and front suspension member brace
rear RH and LH.
Carefully remove the engine assembly from the vehicle.
A
A52335
C
(d)
C
D
D
D
D
Engine Hanger
No. 1
A52336
(e)
Engine Hanger
No. 2
Install the 2 engine hangers as shown in the illustration.
Parts No.:
Engine hanger No. 1
12281-28010
Engine hanger No. 2
12282-28010
Bolt
91512-61020
(f)
Torque: 38 N⋅m (387 kgf⋅cm, 28 ft lbf)
Using a chain block and an engine sling device, hang the
engine assembly.
44.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE VANE PUMP ASSY
Disconnect the PS oil pressure switch connector.
Remove the 2 bolts and vane pump from the engine.
A90847
A13317
45.
46.
REMOVE STABILIZER BAR FRONT (4WD TYPE)
REMOVE RACK & PINION POWER STEERING GEAR ASSY (4WD TYPE)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2521
14-29
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
47.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT FRAME ASSY
Remove the nut installing the engine mounting insulator
LH.
(b)
Remove the nut installing the engine mounting insulator
RH.
(c)
Remove the nut installing the engine mounting insulator
FR.
A52490
A52482
A52441
48.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (4WD TYPE) (See page 30-21 )
49.
(a)
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RR (4WD
TYPE)
Remove the 6 bolts and engine mounting bracket RR.
A52503
50.
51.
52.
53.
54.
REMOVE TRANSFER ASSY (4WD TYPE) (See page 31-9 )
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (See page 30-21 )
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (2WD TYPE) (See page 30-21 )
REMOVE STARTER ASSY (See page 19-4 )
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (See page 40-12 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2522
14-30
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
55.
(a)
REMOVE DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSY
Using SST, fix the crankshaft.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
(b)
Remove the 8 bolts, rear spacer, drive plate and front
spacer.
SST
A36684
A91018
56.
57.
INSTALL ENGINE STAND
REMOVE ENGINE COVER SUB-ASSY NO.1
58.
(a)
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD
Remove the 5 bolts, 2 nuts, intake manifold and gasket.
A61987
59.
(a)
INSPECT INTAKE MANIFOLD
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the surface contacting the cylinder head for warpage.
Maximum warpage: 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
If the warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the manifold.
A85564
60.
61.
62.
63.
64.
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
VENTILATION HOSE No.1
VENTILATION HOSE NO.2
ENGINE WIRE
INTAKE MANIFOLD INSULATOR NO.1
GENERATOR ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2523
14-31
ENGINE MECHANICAL
65.
66.
67.
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAGE SUB-ASSY
REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAGE GUIDE
REMOVE MANIFOLD CONVERTER INSULATOR NO.1
68.
(a)
REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER
SUB-ASSY
Remove the 3 bolts, 2 nuts, and the No. 1 and No. 2 exhaust manifold stays.
A52499
(b)
Remove the 5 nuts, exhaust manifold converter and gasket.
A92868
69.
INSPECT EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER
SUB-ASSY
(a) Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the surface contacting the cylinder head for warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.70 mm (0.0276 in.)
If the warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the manifold.
A85567
70.
71.
72.
73.
REMOVE WATER INLET
REMOVE THERMOSTAT
REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSY
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
74.
(a)
REMOVE V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSY
Remove the bolt, nut and belt tensioner.
A32676
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2524
14-32
ENGINE MECHANICAL
75.
76.
77.
78.
79.
80.
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT BEARING BRACKET (2WD TYPE)
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
REMOVE FUEL DELIVERY PIPE W/INJECTOR (See page 11-10 )
REMOVE WATER BY-PASS PIPE NO.1
REMOVE OIL COOLER PIPE (W/ OIL COOLER)
REMOVE OIL COOLER HOSE (W/ OIL COOLER)
Oil Pressure Switch
81.
(a)
REMOVE ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY
Remove the oil pressure switch.
82.
(a)
REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR
Remove the nut and the sensor.
B11410
A85381
83.
84.
85.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
REPLACE PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY
INSTALL ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Install a new gasket to the sensor.
Install the sensor.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
86.
(a)
Upper
10
Engine
Front
10
INSTALL KNOCK SENSOR
Install the sensor with the nut.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Angling the knock sensor below the horizontal (below 0) is recommended.
A78436
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2525
14-33
ENGINE MECHANICAL
87.
(a)
(b)
88.
(a)
89.
(a)
90.
91.
92.
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY
Clean the threads of the oil pressure switch. Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the oil pressure switch.
Adhesive: Part No. 08833-00080 THREE BOND 1344 or equivalent
Install the oil pressure switch.
Torque: 15 N⋅m (153 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL OIL COOLER PIPE (W/ OIL COOLER)
Install a new gasket and the oil cooler pipe with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL WATER BY-PASS PIPE NO.1
Install a new gasket and the by-pass pipe with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL FUEL DELIVERY PIPE W/INJECTOR (See page 11-10 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Torque: 64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT BEARING BRACKET (2WD TYPE)
Torque: 64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
93.
(a)
INSTALL V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSY
Install the belt tensioner with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 60 N⋅m (612 kgf⋅cm, 44 ft⋅lbf)
A32676
94.
95.
96.
97.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSY
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL THERMOSTAT (See page 16-1 1)
INSTALL WATER INLET
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
98.
2
3
(a)
4
1
INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER
SUB-ASSY
Install a new gasket and the exhaust manifold converter.
Uniformly tighten the 5 nuts in the sequence shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 37 N⋅m (377 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
5
A92868
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2526
14-34
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Install the No. 1 and No. 2 exhaust manifold stays with the
2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 44 N⋅m (449 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
A52499
99.
100.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL MANIFOLD CONVERTER INSULATOR NO.1
INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAGE GUIDE
Apply a light coat of the engine oil to the O-ring and install it to the guide.
Install the oil level gage and guide with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
101. INSTALL GENERATOR ASSY (See page 19-40 )
102. INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Install a new gasket and the intake manifold with the 5
bolts and 2 nuts. Uniformly tighten the bolts in several
passes.
Torque: 30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
A61987
103. INSTALL DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSY
(a) Using SST, fix the crankshaft.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
(b) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the bolt end.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND or equivalent.
SST
A36684
(c)
1
6
3
7
8
4
Install the front spacer, drive plate and rear spacer with 8
bolts. Uniformly tighten the 8 bolts in the sequence shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 98 N⋅m (1,000 kgf⋅cm, 72 ft⋅lbf)
2
5
A61988
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2527
14-35
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
104. INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (See page 40-12 )
105. INSTALL STARTER ASSY (See page 19-4 )
Torque: 39 N⋅m (398 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
106. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (2WD TYPE) (See page 30-21 )
107. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (See page 30-21 )
108. INSTALL TRANSFER ASSY (4WD TYPE) (See page 31-9 )
A
109. INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RR (4WD
TYPE)
(a) Install the mounting bracket with the 6 bolts.
Torque:
34 N⋅m (347 kgf⋅cm, 25 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
A
B
A
B
B
A53010
110. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (4WD TYPE) (See page 30-21 )
111. INSTALL FRONT FRAME ASSY
(a) Install the engine mounting insulator LH with the nut.
Torque: 95 N⋅m (969 kgf⋅cm, 70 ft⋅lbf)
A52490
(b)
Install the engine mounting insulator RH with the nut.
Torque: 95 N⋅m (969 kgf⋅cm, 70 ft⋅lbf)
A52482
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2528
14-36
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(c)
Install the engine mounting insulator FR with the nut.
Torque: 87 N⋅m (887 kgf⋅cm, 64 ft⋅lbf)
(d)
4WD type:
Install the engine mounting insulator RR with 2 nuts.
Torque: 75 N⋅m (765 kgf⋅cm, 55 ft⋅lbf)
A52441
A52340
112. INSTALL RACK & PINION POWER STEERING GEAR ASSY (4WD TYPE)
Torque: 70 N⋅m (714 kgf⋅cm, 52 ft⋅lbf)
113. INSTALL STABILIZER BAR FRONT (4WD TYPE)
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
114. INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSY
(a) Install the vane pump to the engine with the 2 bolts.
(b) Connect the PS oil pressure switch connector.
Torque: 43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
A13317
B
A
B
B
B
A
115. INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE
(a) Set the engine assembly with transaxle on the engine lifter.
(b) Install the engine assembly to the vehicle.
(c) Install the frame side plate LH and RH with the 6 bolts.
Torque:
86 N⋅m (877 kgf⋅cm, 63 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
32 N⋅m (326 kgf⋅cm, 24 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B and nut
A52335
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2529
14-37
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d)
C
C
D
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Install the front suspension member brace rear RH and
LH with the 6 bolts.
Torque:
86 N⋅m (877 kgf⋅cm, 63 ft⋅lbf) for bolt C
32 N⋅m (326 kgf⋅cm, 24 ft⋅lbf) for bolt D and nut
D
D
D
A52336
116. INSTALL COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (See page 55-45 )
117. INSTALL STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
SUB-ASSY
(a) Align the matchmarks on the intermediate shaft and control valve shaft.
Torque: 35 N⋅m (357 kgf⋅cm, 26 ft⋅lbf)
Matchmark
A52331
(b)
Tighten the bolt.
Torque: 35 N⋅m (357 kgf⋅cm, 26 ft⋅lbf)
A52332
118. INSTALL BOLT, W/WASHER
(a) Fix the crankshaft, and install the 6 setting bolts.
Torque: 41 N⋅m (418 kgf⋅cm, 30 ft⋅lbf)
A62253
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2530
14-38
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
119. INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB- ASSY
LOWER NO.1 LH
(a) Install the drive shaft to the steering knuckle.
(b) Install the suspension lower arm with the bolt and the 2
nuts.
Torque: 127 N⋅m (1,295 kgf⋅cm, 94 ft⋅lbf)
C65935
120. INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY LOWER NO.1 RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
121. INSTALL TIE ROD ASSY LH
(a) Connect the tie rod end to the steering knuckle and install a new castle nut.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Prevent any lubricant from contacting the thread and the taper portions.
After tightening the castle nut, tighten it to the additional direction within 60 to put into a cotter
pin.
(b) Insert a new cotter pin.
122. INSTALL TIE ROD ASSY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
123. INSTALL SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
124. INSTALL SPEED SENSOR FRONT RH
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
125. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
(a) Using a 30 mm socket wrench, install a new hub nut.
Torque: 294 N⋅m (3,000 kgf⋅cm, 217 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Using a chisel and hammer, tapped the front axle hub LH
nut.
C65982
126. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB RH NUT
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
127. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
(a) Using a 5 mm socket hexagon wrench, fix the stud bolt and install the nut.
Torque: 74 N⋅m (755 kgf⋅cm, 55 ft⋅lbf)
128. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2531
14-39
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
129. INSTALL PROPELLER SHAFT (4WD TYPE)
(a) Align the matchmarks on both the flanges of the front propeller shaft and intermediate shaft, then install and tighten the 4 bolts, 4 washers and 4 nuts.
Torque: 74 N⋅m (755 kgf⋅cm, 55 ft⋅lbf)
Matchmark
A52514
130. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (See page 15-2 )
131. CONNECT FUEL TUBE SUB-ASSY (See page 11-1 )
132. INSTALL RETURN TUBE SUB-ASSY
(a) Install the return tube with 2 bolts.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
A52493
133. INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page 14-5 )
134. INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET NO.2 RH
Torque: 52 N⋅m (530 kgf⋅cm, 38 ft⋅lbf)
135. INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
W/BRACKET
(a) Install the engine mounting control rod with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
First, loosely install bolts (1) and (2) with your hand. Then use
a wench to install bolt (3). Finally, tighten bolt (2) and (1), in that
order.
1
2
3
A92861
136. INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
Torque: 64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
137. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSY
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
138. ADD TRANSFER OIL
(a) Install a new gasket and the filler plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
139. ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
140. ADD ENGINE OIL
141. ADD COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2532
14-40
ENGINE MECHANICAL
142.
143.
144.
145.
146.
147.
148.
149.
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-6 )
INSPECT FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page 11-1 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See page 26-7 )
CHECK IDLE SPEED AND IGNITION TIMING (See page 14-1 )
INSPECT CO/HC (See page 14-1 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (See page 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2533
14-91
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
141P6-02
COMPONENTS
Valve Lifter
Valve Retainer Lock
Retainer
Inner Compression Spring
Valve Stem Oil O Seal or Ring
Valve Spring Seat
Intake Valve Guide Bush
Valve Lifter
Valve Retainer Lock
Retainer
Inner Compression Spring
Valve Stem Oil O Seal or Ring
Valve Spring Seat
Exhaust Valve Guide Bush
Stud Bolt
10 (102, 7.0)
5.0 (51, 44 in.⋅lbf)
Ring w/ Head Pin
Cylinder Head Assy
5.0 (51, 44 in.⋅lbf)
10 (102, 7.0)
Exhaust Valve
Intake Valve
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm,ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A77366
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2584
14-92
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
141P7-02
OVERHAUL
1.
REMOVE VALVE LIFTER
HINT:
Arrange the valve lifters in the correct order.
2.
(a)
SST
REMOVE INTAKE VALVE
Using SST and wooden blocks, compress and remove
the 8 valve spring retainer locks.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010)
Remove the retainer, valve spring and valve.
(b)
HINT:
Arrange the removed parts in the correct order.
Wooden Blocks
A52444
3.
(a)
SST
REMOVE EXHAUST VALVE
Using SST and wooden blocks, compress and remove
the 8 valve spring retainer locks.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010)
Remove the retainer, valve spring and valve.
(b)
HINT:
Arrange the removed parts in the correct order.
Wooden Blocks A52472
4.
(a)
REMOVE VALVE STEM OIL O SEAL OR RING
Using needle-nose pliers, remove the oil seals.
A13356
5.
6.
REMOVE VALVE SPRING SEAT
REMOVE STUD BOLT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2585
14-93
ENGINE MECHANICAL
7.
(a)
Cylinder Block Side
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD FOR FLATNESS
Using a precision straight edge and a feeler gauge, measure the surface contacting the cylinder block and the
manifolds for warpage.
Maximum warpage:
Item
Specified Condition
Cylinder block side
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Intake manifold side
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust manifold
side
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If the warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the cylinder head.
Intake Manifold Side
Exhaust Manifold Side
A52445
8.
(a)
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD FOR CRACKS
Using a dye penetrate, check the intake ports, exhaust
ports and cylinder surface for cracks.
If cracked, replace the cylinder head.
A13365
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Width
EM0183
A52446
INSPECT VALVE SEATS
Apply a light coat of prussian blue (or white lead) to the
valve face.
Lightly press the valve face against the valve seat.
Check the valve face and valve seat according to the following procedure.
(1) If blue appears 360 around the valve face, the
valve face is concentric. If not, replace the valve.
(2) If blue appears 360around the valve seat, the
guide and valve face are concentric. If not, resurface the valve seat.
(3) Check that the valve seat contact is in the middle of
the valve face with the width between 1.0 to 1.4 mm
(0.039 to 0.055 in.).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2586
14-94
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
10. REPAIR VALVE SEATS
NOTICE:
Keep the lip free from a foreign matter.
(a)
If the seating is too high on the valve face, use 30 and
45 cutters to correct the seat.
(b)
If the seating is too low on the valve face, use 75 and 45
cutters to correct the seat.
Hand-lap the valve and valve seat with an abrasive compound.
Check the valve seating position.
45
30
1.0 to 1.4 mm
(0.039 to 0.055 in.)
A94213
75
45
(c)
(d)
1.0 to 1.4 mm
(0.039 to 0.055 in.)
A94214
11.
(a)
(b)
A36626
INSPECT CAMSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
Install the camshafts.
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while
moving the camshaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
Intake 0.040 to 0.095 mm (0.0016 to 0.0037 in.)
Exhaust 0.080 to 0.135 mm (0.0032 to 0.0053 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
Intake 0.11mm (0.0043 in.)
Exhaust 0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
cylinder head. If the thrust surface is damaged, replace the
camshaft.
12.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSPECT CAMSHAFT OIL CLEARANCE
Clean the bearing caps and camshaft journals.
Place the camshafts on the cylinder head.
Lay a strip of Plastigage across each of the camshaft journal.
A36627
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2587
14-95
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(d)
Install the bearing caps.
Torque:
30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf) for No. 1 bearing cap
30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf) for No. 2 bearing cap
9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf) for No. 3 bearing cap
NOTICE:
Do not turn the camshaft.
A32645
(e)
A36628
Remove the bearing cap, and measure the Plastigage at
its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
Intake No. 1 journal bearing mark 1
0.007 to 0.038 mm (0.0028 to 0.00150 in.)
Intake No. 1 journal bearing mark 2
0.008 to 0.038 mm (0.0031 to 0.00150 in.)
Intake No. 1 journal bearing mark 3
0.008 to 0.038 mm (0.0031 to 0.00150 in.)
Other journals
0.025 to 0.062 mm (0.00098 to 0.00244 in.)
Exhaust No. 1 journal
0.040 to 0.079 mm (0.00157 to 0.00311 in.)
Other journals
0.025 to 0.062 mm (0.00098 to 0.00244 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
Intake No. 1 journal 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Other journals 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
NOTICE:
Completely remove the Plastigage after the inspection.
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
camshaft. If necessary, replace the cylinder head.
If the oil clearance on the No.1 journal is greater than the maximum, choose a new bearing and install it.
HINT:
Cylinder head journal bore diameter
Number Mark
Mark 1
40.000 to 40.008 mm (1.57480 to 1.57511 in.)
Mark 2
40.009 to 40.017 mm (1.57515 to 1.57547 in.)
Mark 3
40.018 to 40.025 mm (1.57551 to 1.57578 in.)
Standard bearing center wall thickness
Number Mark
A13530
Mark 1
2.000 to 2.004 mm (0.07874 to 0.07890 in.)
Mark 2
2.005 to 2.008 mm (0.07894 to 0.07905 in.)
Mark 3
2.009 to 2.012 mm (0.07909 to 0.07921 in.)
Camshaft journal diameter:
35.971 to 35.985 mm (1.41618 to 1.41673 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2588
14-96
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
13.
(a)
INSPECT INNER COMPRESSION SPRING
Using a vernier caliper, measure the free length of the
valve spring.
Free length: 45.7 mm (1.799 in.)
If the free length is not as specified, replace the valve spring.
EM0801
(b)
Using steel squares, measure the deviation of the valve
spring.
Maximum deviation: 1.6 mm (0.063 in.)
If the deviation is greater than the maximum, replace the valve
spring.
Deviation
EM0988
14.
(a)
INSPECT INTAKE VALVE
Using a vernier caliper, measure the valve overall length.
Standard overall length: 101.71 mm (4.0043 in.)
Minimum overall length: 101.21 mm (3.9846 in.)
If the overall length is less than the minimum, replace the valve.
EM2534
(b)
Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the valve
stem.
Valve stem diameter:
5.470 to 5.485 mm (0.2154 to 0.2159 in.)
A32770
(c)
Using a vernier caliper, measure the valve head margin
thickness.
Standard margin thickness:
1.05 to 1.45 mm (0.0413 to 0.0571 in.)
Minimum margin thickness: 0.5 mm (0.0197 in.)
If the margin thickness is less than the minimum, replace the
valve.
Margin
Thickness
EM0181
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2589
14-97
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
15.
(a)
INSPECT EXHAUST VALVE
Using a vernier caliper, measure the valve overall length.
Standard overall length: 101.15 mm (3.9823 in.)
Minimum overall length: 100.70 mm (3.9646 in.)
If the overall length is less than the minimum, replace the valve.
EM2534
(b)
Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the valve
stem.
Valve stem diameter:
5.465 to 5.480 mm (0.2152 to 0.2157 in.)
Z00052
(c)
Using a vernier caliper, measure the valve head margin
thickness.
Standard margin thickness:
1.20 to 1.60 mm (0.0470 to 0.0630 in.)
Minimum margin thickness: 0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
If the margin thickness is less than the minimum, replace the
valve.
Margin
Thickness
EM0181
16.
(a)
A13367
INSPECT INTAKE VALVE GUIDE BUSH
Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of the
guide bush.
Bush inside diameter:
5.510 to 5.530 mm (0.2169 to 0.2177 in.)
(b) Subtract the valve stem diameter measurement from the
guide bush inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.025 to 0.060 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the valve
and guide bush (see steps 18 and 20).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2590
14-98
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
17.
(a)
A13367
INSPECT EXHAUST VALVE GUIDE BUSH
Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of the
guide bush.
Bush inside diameter:
5.510 to 5.530 mm (0.2169 to 0.2177 in.)
(b) Subtract the valve stem diameter measurement from the
guide bush inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.030 to 0.065 mm (0.0012 to 0.0026 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the valve
and guide bush (see steps 19 and 21).
18.
(a)
REMOVE INTAKE VALVE GUIDE BUSH
Using SST and a hammer, tap out the guide bush.
SST 09201-10000 (09201-01050), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
19.
(a)
REMOVE EXHAUST VALVE GUIDE BUSH
Using SST and a hammer, tap out the guide bush.
SST 09201-10000 (09201-01050), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
SST
A36632
SST
20.
(a)
A36633
INSTALL INTAKE VALVE GUIDE BUSH
Using a caliper gauge, measure the bush bore diameter
of the cylinder head.
Diameter: 10.285 to 10.306 mm (0.4049 to 0.4057 in.)
(b) Install the STD bush if the diameter is within the specified
diameter.
Standard diameter:
10.333 to 10.344 mm (0.4068 to 0.4072 in.)
If the diameter is not as specified, replace the STD bush.
(c)
SST
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new guide bush to the
specified protrusion height.
Protrusion height:
9.6 to 10.0 mm (0.3780 to 0.3937 in.)
SST 09201-10000 (09201-01050), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
A36634
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2591
14-99
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d)
21.
(a)
(b)
(c)
SST
(d)
A36635
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Using a sharp 5.5 mm reamer, ream the guide bush to obtain the standard specified clearance between the guide
bush and valve stem.
Standard oil clearance:
0.025 to 0.060 mm (0.00098 to 0.00236 in.)
INSTALL EXHAUST VALVE GUIDE BUSH
Using a caliper gauge, measure the bush bore diameter
of the cylinder head.
Diameter: 10.285 to 10.306 mm (0.4049 to 0.4057 in.)
Install the STD bush if the diameter is within the specified
diameter.
Standard diameter:
10.333 to 10.344 mm (0.4068 to 0.4072 in.)
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new guide bush to the
specified protrusion height.
Protrusion height:
9.6 to 10.0 mm (0.3780 to 0.3937 in.)
Using a sharp 5.5 mm reamer, ream the guide bush to obtain the standard specified clearance between the guide
bush and valve stem.
SST 09201- 10000 (09201- 01050), 09950- 70010
(09951-07100), 23801
Standard oil clearance:
0.030 to 0.065 mm (0.00118 to 0.00256 in.)
22.
(a)
INSPECT VALVE LIFTER
Using a micrometer, measure the lifter diameter.
Lifter diameter:
30.966 to 30.976 mm (1.2191 to 1.2195 in.)
(b)
Using a caliper gauge, measure the lifter bore diameter
of the cylinder head.
Lifter bore diameter:
31.009 to 31.025 mm (1.2208 to 1.2215 in.)
P16860
A13374
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2592
14-100
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(c)
Subtract the lifter diameter measurement from the lifter
bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.033 to 0.059 mm (0.0013 to 0.0023 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the lifter. If necessary, replace the cylinder head.
23.
(a)
Upper Side
INSTALL RING W/HEAD PIN
Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap in a new ring pin to the
specified protrusion height.
Protrusion height: 5.5 mm (0.22 in.)
11 mm (0.43 in.)
5.5 mm
8 mm
(0.31 in.)
[mm]
A62971
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2593
14-101
ENGINE MECHANICAL
24.
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL STUD BOLT
Torque:
5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf) for bolt A
5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf) for bolt B
10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf) for bolt C
10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf) for bolt D
Front
Upper
A
A
Intake Side
Exhaust Side
C
C
B
B
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
D
D
D
D
D
18 mm
(0.71 in.)
14 mm
(0.55 in.)
24 mm
(0.94 in.)
46.5 mm
(1.83 in.)
31.5 mm
(1.24 in.)
(M6)
(M6)
9 mm
(0.35 in.)
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
49.5 mm
(1.95 in.)
(M8)
38.7 mm
(1.52 in.)
(M8)
13 mm
(0.51 in.)
13 mm
(0.51 in.)
A90852
25.
INSTALL VALVE SPRING SEAT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2594
14-102
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Intake Side
Exhaust Side
Gray
Black
A52449
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
26. INSTALL VALVE STEM OIL O SEAL OR RING
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil on a new oil seal.
NOTICE:
Pay close attention when installing the intake and exhaust
oil seals. For example, installing the intake oil seal into the
exhaust or installing the exhaust oil seal to the intake can
cause installation problems later.
HINT:
The intake valve oil seal is gray and the exhaust valve oil seal
is black.
(b) Using SST, push in the oil seal.
SST 09201-41020
SST
A36639
27.
(a)
(b)
SST
Wooden Blocks
A52444
(c)
Using a plastic-faced hammer and a discarded valve with
its tip wrapped in tape, lightly tap the installed valve to ensure that it is securely fit.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the valve stem tip.
Vinyl Tape
Valve Stem
INSTALL INTAKE VALVE
Install the valve, spring and retainer to the cylinder head.
Using SST and wooden blocks, compress the spring and
install the 2 retainer locks.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010)
A13888
28.
(a)
(b)
SST
INSTALL EXHAUST VALVE
Install the valve, spring and retainer to the cylinder head.
Using SST and wooden blocks, compress the spring and
install the 2 retainer locks.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010)
Wooden Blocks A52472
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2595
14-103
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(c)
Using a plastic-faced hammer and a discarded valve with
its tip wrapped in vinyl tape, lightly tap the installed valve
to ensure that it is securely fit.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the valve stem tip.
Vinyl Tape
Valve Stem
-
A13888
29. INSTALL VALVE LIFTER
(a) Assemble the valve lifter and the tip of the valve stem with a light coat of engine oil applied.
NOTICE:
Install the valve lifters in their original places.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2596
14-104
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
141P8-02
COMPONENTS
Piston Ring Set
Piston
Snap Ring
Snap Ring
Piston Pin
Connecting Rod
Connecting Rod Bearing
Cylinder Block Assy
Crankshaft Thrust Washer
Crankshaft Bearing
Crankshaft
Connecting Rod Bearing
Crankshaft Bearing
Connecting Rod Cap
Connecting Rod Bearing Cap Bolt
See page 14-105
1st: 25 (250, 18)
2nd: Turn 90
Crankshaft Bearing Cap
Crankshaft Bearing Cap Bolt
See page 14-105
1st: 20 (204, 15)
2nd: Turn 90
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A88217
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2597
14-105
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
141P9-02
OVERHAUL
1.
(a)
A36642
A13397
INSPECT CONNECTING ROD THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while
moving the connecting rod back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.160 to 0.362 mm (0.0063 to 0.0143 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance: 0.362 mm (0.0143 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
connecting rod assembly(s). If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
2.
INSPECT CONNECTING ROD OIL CLEARANCE
HINT:
The connecting rod cap bolts are tightened in 2 progressive
steps.
(a) Check that the matchmarks on the connecting rod and
cap are aligned to ensure the correct reassembly.
HINT:
The matchmarks on the connecting rods and caps are for ensuring the correct reassembly.
(b) Using a 12 mm socket wrench, remove the 2 connecting
rod cap bolts.
(c) Using the 2 removed connecting rod cap bolts, remove
the connecting rod cap and lower bearing by wiggling the
connecting rod cap right and left.
HINT:
Keep the lower bearing inserted to the connecting rod cap.
(d) Clean the crank pin and bearing.
(e) Check the crank pin and bearing for pitting and scratches.
(f)
Lay a strip of Plastigage on the crank pin.
A13400
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2598
14-106
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(g)
Check that the front mark of the connecting rod cap is facing in the correct direction.
(h) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the heads of the connecting rod cap bolts.
(i)
Install the connecting cap (see step 37).
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
(j)
Remove the 2 bolts and connecting rod cap.
Front Mark
A52515
(k)
Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.024 to 0.048 mm (0.0009 to 0.0019 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If the crank pin or bearing is damaged, replace the bearings. If
necessary, replace the crankshaft.
A36644
Mark
1, 2 or 3
Mark
1, 2 or 3
A13840
HINT:
If replacing a bearing, replace it with one that has the same
number as the connecting rod. There are 3 sizes of standard
bearings: 1, 2 and 3.
Standard bearing center wall thickness:
Mark 1
1.485 to 1.488 mm (0.05854 to 0.05858 in.)
Mark 2
1.489 to 1.491 mm (0.05862 to 0.05870 in.)
Mark 3
1.492 to 1.494 mm (0.05874 to 0.05881 in.)
(l)
Completely remove the Plastigage.
3.
(a)
REMOVE PISTON SUB-ASSY W/CONNECTING ROD
Using a ridge reamer, remove all the carbon from the top
of the cylinder.
Push the piston, connecting rod assembly and upper
bearing through the top of the cylinder block.
(b)
HINT:
A13469
4.
Keep the bearing, connecting rod and cap together.
Arrange the piston and connecting rod assemblies in the
correct order.
REMOVE CONNECTING ROD BEARING
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2599
14-107
ENGINE MECHANICAL
5.
(a)
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(b)
REMOVE PISTON RING SET
Using a piston ring expander, remove the 2 compression
rings.
Remove the 2 side rails and oil ring by hand.
6.
(a)
REMOVE PISTON PIN HOLE SNAP RING
Using a small screwdriver, pry out the 2 snap rings.
7.
(a)
REMOVE PISTON
Gradually heat the piston to approximately 80 to 90C
(176 to 194F).
(b)
Using a plastic-faced hammer and brass bar, lightly tap
out the piston pin and remove the connecting rod.
A36647
A13478
A01178
HINT:
The piston and pin are a matched set.
Arrange the pistons, pins, rings, connecting rods and
bearings in the correct order.
A01179
8.
(a)
A36645
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while
prying the crankshaft back and forth with a screwdriver.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.040 to 0.240 mm (0.0016 to 0.0094 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance: 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
thrust washers as a set.
Thrust washer thickness:
1.930 to 1.980 mm (0.0760 to 0.0780 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2600
14-108
ENGINE MECHANICAL
4
8
10
6
2
3
7
9
5
1
9.
(a)
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT OIL CLEARANCE
Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 main bearing cap
bolts, in the sequence shown in the illustration.
A87780
(b)
A87781
Use 2 removed main bearing cap bolts to remove the 5
main bearing caps and 5 lower bearings.
NOTICE:
Insert the bolts into one of the caps. Ease the cap out by
gently pulling up and applying force toward the front and
back side of the cylinder block, as shown in the illustration.
Take care not to damage the contact surfaces of the cap
and cylinder block.
HINT:
Keep the lower bearing and main bearing cap together.
Arrange the main bearing caps in correct order.
(c) Lift out the crankshaft.
HINT:
Keep the upper bearings together with the cylinder block.
(d) Clean each main journal and bearing.
(e) Check each main journal and bearing for pitting and
scratches.
If the journal or bearing is damaged, replace the bearings.
If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
(f)
Place the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
(g) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each journal.
(h) Install the main bearing caps (see step 36).
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
(i)
Remove the main bearing cap (see steps (a) to (b)
above).
Plastigage
A87782
(j)
Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.024 to 0.048 mm (0.00094 to 0.00189 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
bearings. If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
A87783
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2601
14-109
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(k)
Number Mark
No. 3
No. 4
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
If using a standard bearing, replace it with one having the
same number. If the number of the bearing cannot be determined, select the correct bearing by adding together
the numbers imprinted on the cylinder block and crankshaft, and then select the bearing according to the chart
below. There are 4 sizes of standard bearings: 1, 2, 3, and
4.
Cylinder block
(A)
+
Crankshaft (B)
0 to 2
3 to 5
6 to 8
9 to 11
Use bearing
1
2
3
4
HINT:
EXAMPLE
Cylinder block 4 (A) + Crankshaft 3 (B) =
Total number 7 (Use bearing 3)
No. 1
No. 2
-
No. 5
Number Mark
A87784
Reference:
Item
Mark
Specified Condition
Cylinder block main journal bore diameter (A)
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
59.000 to 59.002 mm (2.32283 to 2.32291 in.)
59.003 to 59.004 mm (2.32294 to 2.32299 in.)
59.005 to 59.006 mm (2.32303 to 2.32307 in.)
59.007 to 59.009 mm (2.32311 to 2.32318 in.)
59.010 to 59.011 mm (2.32322 to 2.32326 in.)
59.012 to 59.013 mm (2.32330 to 2.32334 in.)
59.014 to 59.016 mm (2.32338 to 2.32346 in.)
Crankshaft main journal diameter (B)
0
1
2
3
4
5
54.999 to 55.000 mm (2.16531 to 2.16535 in.)
54.997 to 54.998 mm (2.16523 to 2.16527 in.)
54.995 to 54.996 mm (2.16515 to 2.16519 in.)
54.993 to 54.994 mm (2.16507 to 2.16511 in.)
54.991 to 54.992 mm (2.16500 to 2.16504 in.)
54.989 to 54.990 mm (2.16489 to 2.16496 in.)
Standard bearing center wall thickness
1
2
3
4
1.993 to 1.996 mm (0.07846 to 0.07858 in.)
1.997 to 1.999 mm (0.07862 to 0.07870 in.)
2.000 to 2.002 mm (0.07874 to 0.07882 in.)
2.003 to 2.005 mm (0.07886 to 0.07894 in.)
(l)
Completely remove the Plastigage.
10. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT
(a) Lift out the crankshaft.
(b) Remove the 5 upper main bearings and 2 thrust washers from the cylinder block.
HINT:
Arrange the main bearings and thrust washers in the correct order.
11. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT THRUST WASHER UPPER
12. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT BEARING
HINT:
Arrange the bearings in the correct order.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2602
14-1 10
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
13. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT BEARING NO.2
HINT:
Arrange the main bearings and thrust washers in the correct order.
14. REMOVE STUD BOLT
15. CLEAN CYLINDER BLOCK
NOTICE:
If the cylinder is washed at high temperatures, the cylinder liner sticks out beyond the cylinder block.
Always wash the cylinder block at a temperature of 45C (113F) or less.
16.
(a)
INSPECT CYLINDER BLOCK FOR FLATNESS
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the surface contacting the cylinder head gasket for
warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the cylinder block.
A36648
17.
(a)
INSPECT CYLINDER BORE
Using a cylinder gauge, measure the cylinder bore diameter at positions A and B in the thrust and axial directions.
Standard diameter:
88.500 to 88.513 mm (3.4842 to 3.4848 in.)
Maximum diameter: 88.633 mm (3.4895 in.)
If the measured diameters is greater than the standard, replace
the cylinder block.
Thrust Direction
Front
Axial Direction
A
B
10 mm
(0.39 in.)
A88899
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2603
14-1 11
ENGINE MECHANICAL
18.
(a)
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT PISTON DIAMETER
Using a micrometer, measure the piston diameter at right
angles to the piston pin center line, 30.3 mm (1.193 in.)
from the piston head.
Piston diameter:
88.439 to 88.449 mm (3.4818 to 3.4822 in.)
30.3 mm
(1.193 in.)
A13486
19.
(a)
INSPECT PISTON CLEARANCE
Subtract the piston diameter measurement from the cylinder bore diameter measurement.
Specified oil clearance: 0.051 to 0.100 mm (0.0020 to 0.0039 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum, replace all the 4 pistons. If necessary, replace the cylinder
block.
20. INSPECT RING GROOVE CLEARANCE
(a) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the piston ring and the wall of the ring groove.
Ring groove clearance:
0.030 to 0.070 mm (0.0012 to 0.0028 in.)
If the clearance is not as specified, replace the piston.
A36650
21.
(a)
INSPECT PISTON RING END GAP
Using a piston, push the piston ring a little beyond the bottom of the ring travel, 110 mm (4.33 in.) from the top of the
cylinder block.
110 mm
Piston Ring
A53017
(b)
EM2552
Using a feeler gauge, measure the end gap.
Standard end gap:
No. 1 0.22 to 0.32 mm (0.0087 to 0.0126 in.)
No. 2 0.50 to 0.60 mm (0.0197 to 0.0236 in.)
Oil (side rail) 0.10 to 0.35 mm (0.0039 to 0.0138 in.)
Maximum end gap:
No. 1 0.89 mm (0.0350 in.)
No. 2 1.35 mm (0.0531 in.)
Oil (side rail) 0.73 mm (0.0287 in.)
If the end gap is greater than the maximum, replace the piston
ring. If the end gap is greater than the maximum even with a
new piston ring, replace the cylinder block.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2604
14-1 12
ENGINE MECHANICAL
22.
(a)
A13490
(b)
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSPECT PISTON PIN OIL CLEARANCE
Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of the
piston bushing.
Pin hole bush diameter:
22.001 to 22.010 mm (0.8662 to 0.8665 in.)
Pin hole bush diameter (Reference):
Mark
Specified Condition
A
22.001 to 22.004 mm (0.86618 to 0.86630 in.)
B
22.005 to 22.007 mm (0.86634 to 0.86612 in.)
C
22.008 to 22.010 mm (0.86645 to 0.86653 in.)
Using a micrometer, measure the piston pin diameter.
Piston pin diameter:
21.997 to 22.009 mm (0.8660 to 0.8665 in.)
Piston pin diameter (Reference):
Mark
Specified Condition
A
21.997 to 22.000 mm (0.86602 to 0.86614 in.)
B
22.001 to 22.003 mm (0.86618 to 0.86626 in.)
C
22.004 to 22.006 mm (0.86630 to 0.86638 in.)
EM0227
(c)
A01185
Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of the
connecting rod bush.
Bush inside diameter:
22.005 to 22.014 mm (0.8663 to 0.8667 in.)
Bush inside diameter:
Mark
Specified Condition
A
22.005 to 22.008 mm (0.8663 to 0.8665 in.)
B
22.008 to 22.011 mm (0.8665 to 0.8666 in.)
C
22.011 to 22.014 mm (0.8666 to 0.8667 in.)
(d)
Subtract the piston pin diameter measurement from the
piton pin bush hole diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.001 to 0.007 mm (0.00004 to 0.00028 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.010 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace the connecting rod. If necessary, replace the piston and piston pin as
a set.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2605
14-1 13
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Piston Bushing
Inside Diameter
Mark
Front Mark
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
connecting rod. If necessary, replace the piston and piston pin
as a set.
(e) Subtract the piston pin diameter measurement from the
bushing inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.005 to 0.011 mm (0.0002 to 0.0004 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.010 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
connecting rod. If necessary, replace the connecting rod and
piston pin as a set.
Front Mark
Connecting Rod
Bushing Inside Diameter Mark
A62247
23.
(a)
INSPECT CONNECTING ROD SUB-ASSY
Using a rod aligner and feeler gauge, check the connecting rod alignment.
(1) Check for out-of-alignment.
Maximum out-of-alignment:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If the out-of-alignment is greater than the maximum, replace
the connecting rod assembly.
Z00064
(2) Check for twist.
Maximum twist:
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If the twist is greater than the maximum, replace the connecting
rod assembly.
Z00065
24.
(a)
INSPECT CONNECTING ROD BOLT
Using a vernier caliper, measure the tension portion diameter of the bolt.
Standard diameter: 7.2 to 7.3 mm (0.283 to 0.287 in.)
Maximum diameter: 7.0 mm (0.276 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the bolt.
A01470
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2606
14-1 14
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
25.
(a)
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT
Using a dial indicator and V-blocks, measure the circle
runout, as shown in the illustration.
Maximum circle runout: 0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than the maximum, replace the
crankshaft.
A13491
(b)
Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of each main
journal.
Diameter:
54.988 to 55.000 mm (2.16488 to 2.16535 in.)
If the diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance (see
step 26). If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
(c) Check each main journal for taper and out-of-round as
shown in the illustration.
Maximum taper and out-of-round:
0.003 mm (0.0001 in.)
If the taper and out-of-round is greater than the maximum, replace the crankshaft.
Diameter (Reference):
A36653
Mark
Specified Condition
0
54.999 to 55.000 mm (2.16531 to 2.16535 in.)
1
54.997 to 54.998 mm (2.16523 to 2.16527 in.)
2
54.995 to 54.996 mm (2.16515 to 2.16519 in.)
3
54.993 to 54.994 mm (2.16507 to 2.16511 in.)
4
54.991 to 54.992 mm (2.16499 to 2.16504 in.)
5
54.989 to 54.990 mm (2.16491 to 2.16495 in.)
(d)
ZF6928
Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of each crank
pin.
Diameter: 47.990 to 48.000 mm (1.8894 to 1.8898 in.)
If the diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance (see
step 2). If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
(e) Check each crank pin for taper and out-of-round as
shown in the illustration.
Maximum taper and out-of-round:
0.003 mm (0.0001 in.)
If the taper and out-of-round is greater than the maximum, replace the crankshaft.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2607
14-1 15
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
26.
(a)
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT BEARING CAP SET BOLT
Using a vernier caliper, measure the tension portion diameter of the bolt.
Standard diameter: 7.3 to 7.6 mm (0.287 to 0.299 in.)
Minimum diameter: 7.2 mm (0.283 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the bolt.
27. INSTALL RING PIN
A01194
(a)
Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap into the ring pin.
Bottom Side
Upper Side
A
A
A
14 mm
(0.55 in.)
A
13 mm
(0.51 in.)
B
B
6.0 mm (0.24 in.) for Ring Pin A
5.0 mm (0.20 in.) for Ring Pin B
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
A92404
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2608
14-1 16
ENGINE MECHANICAL
28.
(a)
(b)
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL TIGHT PLUG
Apply adhesive around the tight plugs.
Adhesive: Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324
or equivalent.
Using SST, install new tight plugs as shown in the illustration.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00200), 09950- 70010
(09951-07100)
Standard depth:
Engine front
1.7 to 2.7 mm (0.067 to 0.106 in.)
Engine rear
2.2 to 3.2 mm (0.087 to 0.126 in.)
A62239
29.
(a)
INSTALL STUD BOLT
Install the stud bolts as shown in the illustration.
Torque:
5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf) for stud bolt A
10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft.lbf) for stud bolt B
5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf) for stud bolt C
Front Side
C
A
Exhaust Side
16 mm
(0.63 in.)
A
B
18 mm
(0.71 in.)
14 mm
(0.55 in.)
84 mm
(3.31 in.)
31.5 mm
(1.24 in.)
27.5 mm
(1.08 in.)
20 mm
(0.79 in.)
9.0 mm
(0.35 in.)
A (M16)
B (M10)
9.0mm
(0.35 in.)
C (M6)
A92178
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2609
14-1 17
ENGINE MECHANICAL
30.
(a)
Rear Side
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL STRAIGHT PIN
Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap into the straight pin.
Bottom Side
Front Side
A
A
B
A
B
A
10 mm
(0.39 in.)
8.0 mm
(0.31 in.)
15 mm
(0.59 in.)
A
7.5 mm (0.30 in.) for Pin A
12 mm (0.47 in.) for Pin B
22 mm
(0.87 in.)
B
A92406
31.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL PISTON
Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring at one
end of the piston pin hole.
Gradually heat the piston to approximately 80 to 90C
(176 to 194F).
A32958
P12418
(c)
(d)
Front Mark
Align the front marks of the piston and connecting rod,
and push in the piston with your thumb.
Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring on the
other end of the piston pin hole.
Front Mark
A13497
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2610
14-1 18
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
32.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL PISTON RING SET
Install the oil ring expander and 2 side rails by hand.
Using a piston ring expander, install the 2 compression
rings with the painted mark as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Install the compression ring No. 2 with the code mark (2N)
facing upward.
Upward
No. 1
Painted Mark
No. 2
Code Mark (2N)
A52526
No. 1 and
Expander
(c)
Side Rail Lower
Position the piston rings so that the ring ends are as
shown in the illustration.
Front
Side Rail Upper
No. 2
Compression
A52527
33.
(a)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT BEARING
Install the upper bearing with an oil groove on the cylinder
block.
NOTICE:
Clean the contact surfaces of the bearing and the cylinder
block. The surfaces should be free of dust and oils.
A53029
34. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT BEARING NO.2
(a) Install the lower bearing on bearing cap.
NOTICE:
Clean the contact surfaces of the bearing and the bearing
cap. The surfaces should be free of dust and oils.
A33379
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2611
14-1 19
ENGINE MECHANICAL
35.
(a)
36.
(a)
(b)
A13501
(c)
7
3
1
5
9
8
4
2
6
10
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT THRUST WASHER UPPER
Install the 2 thrust washers under the No. 3 journal position of the cylinder block with the oil grooves facing outward.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT
Apply engine oil to upper bearing and install the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
Examine the front marks and numbers and install the
bearing caps on the cylinder block.
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the head of bearing cap bolts.
(d)
Install and uniformly tighten 10 main bearing cap bolts in
several passes,in the sequence shown.
Torque: 40 N⋅m (408 kgf⋅cm, 30 ft⋅lbf)
(e)
(f)
Mark the front side of the bearing cap bolts with paint.
Retighten the bearing cap bolts 90in the sequence
shown.
Check that the painted mark is now at a 90angle to the
front.
Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
A87780
90
Paint
Mark
Engine Front
(g)
(h)
A50671
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2612
14-120
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (2AZ-FE)
37.
(a)
Claw
A50672
INSTALL CONNECTING ROD BEARING
Align the bearing claw with the groove of the connecting
rod or connecting cap.
NOTICE:
Clean the backside of the bearing and the bearing surface
of the connecting rod. The surface should be free of dust
and oil.
38. INSTALL PISTON
NOTICE:
The connecting rod cap bolts are tightened in 2 progressive steps.
(a) Apply engine oil to the cylinder walls, the pistons, and the
surfaces of connecting rod bearings.
(b) Check the position of the piston ring ends.
(c)
Using a piston ring compressor, push the correctly numbered piston and connecting rod assemblies into each
cylinder with the front mark of the piston facing forward.
NOTICE:
Match the numbered connecting rod cap with the connecting rod.
Front Mark
Front
A52528
(d)
Front Mark
(e)
(f)
(g)
Check that the protrusion of the connecting rod cap is facing in the correct direction.
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the heads of the connecting rod cap bolts.
Using a 12 mm socket wrench, uniformly tighten the 2
bolts.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
Mark the front of the connecting cap bolts with paint.
A52515
90
(h)
(i)
Paint
Mark
Engine Front
Retighten the cap bolts 90 as shown in the illustration.
Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
SST 09011-38121
A50671
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2613
14-84
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET (2AZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET (2AZ-FE)
141PA-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
WORK FOR PREVENTING GASOLINE FROM SPILLING OUT (See page 11-1 )
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER (W/ FRONT SUSPENSION
BRACE UPPER CENTER)
DRAIN COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
DRAIN TRANSFER OIL (4WD TYPE)
DISCONNECT RADIATOR HOSE OUTLET
DISCONNECT UNION TO CONNECTOR TUBE HOSE
DISCONNECT HEATOR INLET WATER HOSE
DISCONNECT FUEL TUBE SUB-ASSY (See page 11-10 )
SEPARATE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (4WD TYPE) (See page 30-21 )
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
(a)
SEPARATE ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR ASSY
RR (4WD TYPE)
Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the engine mounting
insulator.
A52340
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RR (4WD TYPE) (See page 14-24 )
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD (See page 14-24 )
DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD INSULATOR NO.1
REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD HEAT INSULATOR NO.1
REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-24 )
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
REMOVE CHAIN SUB-ASSY (See page 14-68 )
REMOVE NO.2 CAMSHAFT (See page 14-41 )
REMOVE CAMSHAFT (See page 14-41 )
REMOVE CAMSHAFT BEARING NO.2
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
3
7
9
6
1
5
10
8
2
4
23.
(a)
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSY
Using a 10 mm Bi-hexagon wrench, uniformly loosen the
10 bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 10 cylinder head bolts and plate washers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop washers into the cylinder head.
Head warpage or cracking could result from removing bolts in an incorrect order.
A94200
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2577
14-85
ENGINE MECHANICAL
24.
25.
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET (2AZ-FE)
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD SET BOLT (See page 14-41 )
Lot No.
26.
(a)
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
Place a new gasket on the cylinder block surface with the
Lot No. stamp upward.
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from contact surface.
Be careful of the installation direction.
To avoid damage to the gasket, place the cylinder
head on the gasket carefully.
INTAKE
Engine
Front
EXHAUST
A90968
27. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSY
HINT:
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 progressive steps.
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the bolt threads and the area beneath the bolt heads that come in
contact with the washers.
(b) Install the bolts and plate washers to the cylinder head.
NOTICE:
Do not drop the washers into the cylinder head.
8
4
2
5
10
6
1
3
9
7
(c)
Using a 10 mm bi-hexagon wrench, uniformly tighten the
10 bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 79 N⋅m (806 kgf⋅cm, 58 ft⋅lbf)
(d)
(e)
Mark the front side of the cylinder head bolt with paint.
Retighten the cylinder head bolts 90 in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
Check that the painted mark is now at a 90 angle to the
front.
A94195
90
(f)
Engine
Front
Paint Mark
A00976
28.
29.
30.
31.
A53074
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL CAMSHAFT BEARING NO.2
INSTALL CAMSHAFT (See page 14-41 )
INSTALL NO.2 CAMSHAFT (See page 14-41 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2578
14-86
ENGINE MECHANICAL
32.
33.
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL CHAIN SUB-ASSY (See page 14-68 )
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
34.
2
3
(a)
4
1
INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER
SUB-ASSY
Install a new gasket and the exhaust manifold convert
with the 5 nuts. Uniformly tighten the nuts in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 37 N⋅m (337 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
5
A92868
(b)
Install the No. 1 and No. 2 exhaust manifold stays with the
2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 44 N⋅m (449 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
A52499
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD HEAT INSULATOR NO.1
Torque: 12 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD INSULATOR NO.1
INSTALL ENGINE WIRE
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD (See page 14-24 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RR (4WD TYPE) (See page 14-24 )
40.
(a)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR ASSY RR
(4WD TYPE)
Install the mounting insulator with bolts.
Torque: 75 N⋅m (765 kgf⋅cm, 55 ft⋅lbf)
A52340
41.
42.
43.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (4WD TYPE) (See page 30-21 )
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
CONNECT FUEL TUBE SUB-ASSY (See page 11-10 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2579
14-87
ENGINE MECHANICAL
44.
45.
46.
47.
(a)
48.
49.
50.
51.
52.
53.
54.
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
ADD ENGINE OIL
ADD COOLANT (see page 16-6 )
ADD TRANSFER OIL (4WD TYPE)
Install a new gasket and the filler plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
CHECK FOR OIL LEAKS
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-6 )
INSPECT FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page 11-4 )
CHECK IDLE SPEED AND IGNITION TIMING (See page 14-1 )
INSPECT CO/HC (See page 14-1 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
INSPECT FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See page 26-7 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2580
14-79
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (2AZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (2AZ-FE)
141PC-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD FRONT RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE ENGINE COVER SUB-ASSY NO.1
REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSY
REMOVE SPARK PLUG
DISCONNECT VENTILATION HOSE
DISCONNECT VENTILATION HOSE NO.2
DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-41 )
SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION (See page 14-6 )
REMOVE CHAIN TENSIONER ASSY NO.1 (See page 14-41 )
Loosen
13.
(a)
REMOVE NO.2 CAMSHAFT (EXHAUST)
Fix the camshaft with a wrench, and then loosen the
sprocket bolt.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the valve lifter.
Fix
A52454
1
3
5
4
2
(b)
Loosen and remove the bearing cap bolts on No. 2 camshaft (exhaust) in the sequence shown in the illustration
in several passes, and remove the 5 bearing caps.
(c)
Raise the No. 2 camshaft (exhaust) and remove it. Then
remove the sprocket bolt.
Disconnect the camshaft timing sprocket (with the timing
chain) from the No. 2 camshaft (exhaust).
Remove the camshaft timing sprocket from the timing
chain.
A36530
(d)
(e)
A86659
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2572
14-80
ENGINE MECHANICAL
1
3
5
4
14.
(a)
2
(b)
-
CAMSHAFT (2AZ-FE)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Loosen the bearing cap bolts on camshaft (intake) in the
sequence shown in the illustration in several passes, and
remove the caps.
Remove the camshaft.
A36531
(c) Tie the timing chain with a string.
NOTICE:
Do not drop anything inside the timing chain cover.
A52474
15.
(a)
Advanced
Angle Side
(b)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
Fix the camshaft (intake) with a vise, and make sure that
the camshaft timing gear does not rotate.
Cover all the paths with vinyl tape except the advanced
side path shown in the illustration.
A90848
Using an air gun, apply about 150 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm2, 21
psi) of air pressure to the port on the advanced angle side.
CAUTION:
Some oil spraying will occur. Contain the spray with a shop
rag.
HINT:
This operation releases the lock pin for the extreme retarded
angle lock.
(d) Under the condition above, check that the camshaft timing gear can be turned by hand to the advanced angle
side (counterclockwise), the direction of the arrow in the
illustration.
Standard: Must turn
HINT:
The camshaft timing gear will turn to the advanced angle side
without applying force by hand depending on the force of the
air pressure applied. Also, if applying pressure to the oil path is
difficult as a result of air leakage from the port, the lock pin may
be difficult to be released.
(c)
A31032
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2573
14-81
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (2AZ-FE)
(e) Remove the fringe bolt from the camshaft timing gear.
NOTICE:
Be sure not to remove the other 4 bolts.
If planning to reuse the camshaft timing gear assembly, release the straight pin lock first, and then install
the gear.
A32639
16.
(a)
Straight
Pin
Key
Groove
A31033
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
Put the camshaft timing gear and the camshaft (intake)
together with the straight pin and key groove.
(b) Turn the camshaft timing gear (as shown in the illustration) while pushing it lightly against the camshaft (intake).Push further at the position where the pin gets into
the groove.
NOTICE:
Be sure not to turn the camshaft timing gear to the retarded
angle side (to the right direction).
(c) Check that there is no clearance between the gear’s
fringe and the camshaft (intake).
(d) Tighten the fringe bolt with the camshaft timing gear fixed.
Torque: 54 N⋅m (551 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the head of the bolt.
Length of sprocket bolt excluding bolt head: 40 mm (1.57
in.)
(e) Check that the camshaft timing gear can move to the retarded angle side (to the right direction) and is locked at
the extreme retarded angle.
17.
(a)
Paint Mark
INSTALL CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Install the timing chain on the camshaft timing gear, with
the painted mark of the link aligned with the timing marks
of the camshaft timing sprocket.
Timing Marks
A52456
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2574
14-82
ENGINE MECHANICAL
5 3
1
2
(b)
4
Bearing Cap No. 1 Bearing Cap No. 3 A92649
Paint Mark
Timing Mark
-
CAMSHAFT (2AZ-FE)
Examine the front marks and numbers of the 5 bearing
caps and install them. Then install the 10 bearing cap
bolts. Uniformly tighten the bolts in the sequence shown
in the illustration.
Torque:
30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf) for bearing cap No. 1
9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf) for bearing cap No. 3
HINT:
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under the
heads of the bolts.
18. INSTALL NO.2 CAMSHAFT (EXHAUST)
(a) Put the camshaft on the cylinder head with the painted
mark of the link of chain aligned with the timing mark of the
camshaft timing sprocket.
A53011
(b)
Raising the camshaft, temporarily tighten the sprocket
bolt.
(c)
Examine the front marks and numbers of the 5 bearing
caps and install them. Then install the 10 bearing cap
bolts. Uniformly tighten the bolts in the sequence shown
in the illustration.
Torque:
30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf) for bearing cap No. 2
9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf) for bearing cap No. 3
A52473
Bearing Cap No. 2
5
3
Bearing Cap No. 3
1
Tighten
2
4
A94196
Fix
A52459
HINT:
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under the
heads of the bolts.
(d) Fix the camshaft with a wrench, and then tighten the
sprocket bolt.
Torque: 54 N⋅m (551 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the head of the bolt.
Length of sprocket bolt excluding bolt head: 25 mm (0.98
in.)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the valve lifter.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2575
14-83
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(e)
7 Links
Paint Mark
Timing Marks
-
CAMSHAFT (2AZ-FE)
As shown in the illustration, check the paint marks of the
timing chain, camshaft timing gear and camshaft timing
sprocket and the alignment of the pulley groove with timing mark of the chain cover.
Paint Mark
Timing Mark
Groove
A52460
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
INSTALL CHAIN TENSIONER ASSY NO.1 (See page 14-68 )
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-41 )
CONNECT ENGINE WIRE
INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSY
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL SPARK PLUG
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2576
14-89
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL (2AZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL (2AZ-FE)
141PE-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (See page 40-12 )
HINT:
Remove and install the transaxle after removing the engine assy w/ transaxle.
2.
(a)
REMOVE DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSY
Using SST, fix the crankshaft.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
(b)
Remove the 8 bolts, rear spacer, drive plate and front
spacer.
SST
A36684
A91018
Cut Position
3.
REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
(a) Using a knife, cut through the oil seal lip.
(b) Using a screwdriver with its tip taped, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
After the removal, check the crankshaft for damage. If it is
damaged, smooth the surface with 400-grit sandpaper.
A53052
SST
A32658
4.
INSTALL ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
(a) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
NOTICE:
Keep the lip free from foreign matter.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST 09223-15030, 09950-70010 (09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Wipe off extra grease from the crankshaft.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2582
14-90
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL (2AZ-FE)
5.
(a)
INSTALL DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSY
Using SST, fix the crankshaft.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
(b)
(c)
Clean the bolt and the bolt hole.
Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the bolt end.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND or equivalent
Install the front spacer, drive plate and rear spacer with
the 8 bolts. Uniformly tighten the bolts in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 98 N⋅m (1,000 kgf⋅cm, 72 ft⋅lbf)
SST
A36684
1
6
3
(d)
7
8
4
2
5
A61988
6.
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (See page 40-12 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2583
14-88
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING CHAIN CASE OIL
SEAL (2AZ-FE)
TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING CHAIN CASE OIL
SEAL (2AZ-FE)
141PD-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD FRONT RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE ENGINE COVER SUB-ASSY NO.1
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD W/BRACKET (See page 14-24 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET NO.2 RH
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page 14-5 )
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-41 )
11.
(a)
SST
REMOVE TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING CHAIN
CASE OIL SEAL
Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09308-10010, 09950-60010 (09951-00200)
SST
A87778
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
INSTALL TIMING GEAR CASE OR TIMING CHAIN
CASE OIL SEAL
(a) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
NOTICE:
Keep the lip free from a foreign matter.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST 09223-22010
SST
NOTICE:
A94207
Wipe off extra grease from the crankshaft.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-41 )
INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page 14-5 )
Torque: 52 N⋅m (531 kgf⋅cm, 38 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET NO.2 RH
Torque: 52 N⋅m (531 kgf⋅cm, 38 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
Torque: 64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD W/BRACKET (See page 14-24 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2581
14-68
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CHAIN (2AZ-FE)
CHAIN (2AZ-FE)
141PB-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
(a)
REMOVE HOOD SUB-ASSY
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD FRONT RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
Install a new gasket and the drain plug after draining engine oil.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
7.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT
8.
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD W/BRACKET (See page 14-24 )
9.
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
10. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET NO.2 RH
11. REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page 14-5 )
12. REMOVE ENGINE COVER SUB-ASSY NO.1
13. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
14. REMOVE GENERATOR ASSY
15. REMOVE VANE PUMP ASSY (See page 51-8 )
NOTICE:
Do not disconnect the hose.
16. REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSY
17. DISCONNECT VENTILATION HOSE No.1
18. DISCONNECT VENTILATION HOSE NO.2
19. REMOVE ENGINE COVER SUB-ASSY NO.1
20. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY (Seepage 14-41 )
21. SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION (See page 14-6 )
22.
SST
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(1) Using SST, fix the pulley and loosen the bolt.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
A36684
(2) Using SST, remove the bolt and pulley.
SST 09950- 50013 (09951- 05010, 09952- 05010,
09953-05020, 09954-05021)
SST
A36685
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2561
14-69
ENGINE MECHANICAL
23.
24.
25.
26.
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
-
CHAIN (2AZ-FE)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
OIL PAN SUB-ASSY (Seepage 14-41 )
CHAIN TENSIONER ASSY NO.1 (See page 14-41 )
V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSY (See page 14-24 )
Engine Hanger
No.1
27.
(a)
Engine Hanger
No.2
INSTALL ENGINE HANGER NO.1
Install the engine hanger No. 1 and No. 2 with the bolts
as shown in the illustration.
Parts No.:
Engine hanger No. 1
12281-28010
Engine hanger No. 2
12282-28010
Bolt
91512-61020
Torque: 38 N⋅m (387 kgf⋅cm, 30 ft⋅lbf)
A52507
28. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
(a) Attach the engine chain hoist to the engine hangers.
CAUTION:
Do not attempt to hang the engine by hooking the chain to
any other part.
(b) Remove the bolt and disconnect the engine mounting insulator FR.
A52441
(c)
Remove the bolt and disconnect the steering gear return
hose clamp from the frame.
(d)
Remove the 4 nuts from the engine mounting insulator
RH.
Raise the engine and remove the engine mounting insulator RH.
A59901
(e)
A59900
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2562
14-70
ENGINE MECHANICAL
29.
(a)
-
CHAIN (2AZ-FE)
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Remove the 3 bolts and engine mounting bracket.
A52481
30.
REMOVE TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER
SUB-ASSSY
(a) Remove the stud bolt for the drive belt tensioner from the
cylinder block.
(b) Remove the 14 bolts and 2 nuts.
(c) Pry out the timing chain cover with a screwdriver.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the timing
chain cover, cylinder block and cylinder head.
A77251
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
Groove
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PLATE NO.1
CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER NO.1
CHAIN SUB-ASSY
CRANKSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR SPROCKET
36. REMOVE NO.2 CHAIN SUB-ASSY
90
(a) Turn the crankshaft counterclockwise 90, and align an
adjusting hole of the oil pump driven sprocket with the
groove of the oil pump.
A52508
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2563
14-71
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CHAIN (2AZ-FE)
(b)
Put a bar (φ 4.0 mm (0.16 in.)) in the adjusting hole of the
oil pump driven sprocket to temporarily lock the sprocket
in position. Remove the nut.
(c)
(d)
Remove the bolt, chain tensioner plate and spring.
Remove the chain tensioner, oil pump driven sprocket
and chain.
37.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL NO.2 CHAIN SUB-ASSY
Set the crankshaft key into the left horizontal position.
Turn the cutout of the drive shaft to the top.
(c)
Align the mark links (yellow colored links) with the timing
marks of the sprocket as shown in the illustration.
Insert the sprockets with chain to the crankshaft and oil
pump shaft.
Temporarily tighten the oil pump driven sprocket with the
nut.
Groove
A52509
B11415
B11424
Mark Link
Timing Mark
(d)
(e)
Timing Mark
Mark Link
A94198
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2564
14-72
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Chain Tensioner Plate
-
CHAIN (2AZ-FE)
(f)
Insert the damper spring into the adjusting hole, and
install the chain tensioner plate with the nut.
Torque: 12 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9.0 ft⋅lbf)
(g)
Align the adjusting hole of the oil pump driven sprocket
with the groove of the oil pump.
Put a bar (φ 4 mm (0.16 in.)) in the adjusting hole of the
oil pump driven sprocket to temporarily lock the sprocket
in position. Install the nut.
Torque: 30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
Bolt
Spring
A90851
(h)
Groove
A52512
(i)
90
Rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise 90, and align
the crankshaft key to the top.
A36525
38.
INSTALL CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER NO.1
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2565
14-73
ENGINE MECHANICAL
39.
(a)
-
CHAIN (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL CHAIN SUB-ASSY
Set the No.1 cylinder to TDC/compression.
(1) Align the timing marks of the camshaft timing
sprockets and bearing caps (No. 1 and No. 2).
Timing Marks
Timing Marks
A53018
(2)
Using the crankshaft pulley bolt, turn the crankshaft
and set the set key on the crankshaft upward.
A52505
(b)
Align the mark link (gold or orange colored link) with the
timing mark of the crankshaft timing sprocket.
(c)
Using SST, tap in the sprocket.
SST 09309-37010
Timing Mark
Mark Link
A52523
SST
A13337
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2566
14-74
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d)
Mark Links
Timing Mark
Timing Marks
-
CHAIN (2AZ-FE)
Align the mark links (gold or yellow colored links) with the
timing marks of the camshaft timing gear and camshaft
timing sprocket. Install the chain.
A52513
40.
41.
INSTALL CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PLATE NO.1 (See page 14-41 )
42.
B
A
Seal
Cylinder Head
Packing
Gasket
Cylinder
Head
A
Seal Packing
B
Cylinder
Seal
Block
Seal Packing
Packing
Seal Width: 2.0 mm
A90970
INSTALL TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER
SUB-ASSSY
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Install the chain cover within 3 minutes after applying
seal packing.
Do not start the engine for at least 2 hours after installing.
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful
not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the timing
chain cover, cylinder head and cylinder block.
(b) Apply seal packing in a continuous bead (seal width: 2.0
mm (0.079 in.)) as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
(c)
Apply seal packing in a continuous bead (seal width: 3.0
to 4.0 mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)) as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
4.0 mm
(0.16 in.)
A
A
2.5 mm
(0.098 in.)
A
Seal Width:
3.0 to 4.0 mm
A
A94199
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2567
14-75
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d)
C
Nut
Nut
C
C
C
(e)
C
A
B
-
CHAIN (2AZ-FE)
Install the timing chain cover with the 14 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque:
9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf) for bolt A
21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf) for bolt C
9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf) for nut
Install the stud bolt to the drive belt tensioner.
Torque: 10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf)
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
A77251
43.
44.
INSTALL CHAIN TENSIONER ASSY NO.1
INSTALL V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSY (See page 14-24 )
45.
(a)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Install the engine mounting bracket with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 54 N⋅m (551 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
46.
INSTALL TRANSVERSE ENGINE ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR
Raise the engine and install the engine mounting insulator RH.
Install the engine mounting insulator RH with the 4 nuts.
Torque:
95 N⋅m (969 kgf⋅cm, 70 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
87 N⋅m (887 kgf⋅cm, 64 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
A52481
A
(a)
(b)
B
B
B
A59900
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2568
14-76
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CHAIN (2AZ-FE)
(c)
Install the steering gear return hose clamp to the frame
with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
(d)
Install the engine mounting insulator FR with the bolt.
Torque: 87 N⋅m (887 kgf⋅cm, 64 in.⋅lbf)
A59901
A52441
47.
48.
INSTALL OIL PAN SUB-ASSY (See page 14-41 )
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (See page 14-41 )
49.
(a)
SST
A53034
Raise
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
Install the crankshaft pulley.
(1) Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the
pulley, and side on the pulley.
(2) Using SST, install the pulley bolt.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
Torque: 180 N⋅m (1,835 kgf⋅cm, 133 ft lbf)
HINT:
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the bolt threads and the area
beneath the bolt heads that come in contact with the washers.
50. INSTALL CHAIN TENSIONER ASSY NO.1
(a) Release the ratchet pawl, fully push in the plunger and apply the hook to the pin so that the plunger cannot spring
out.
Push
Pin
Hook
A52461
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2569
14-77
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CHAIN (2AZ-FE)
(b)
Install a new gasket and the chain tensioner with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
If the hook is released while inserting, apply the hook
again, and insert the chain tensioner.
Engine
Front
A52462
(c)
Turn the crankshaft counterclockwise and check that the
plunger knock pin is disconnected from the hook.
(d)
Turn the crankshaft clockwise and check that the slipper
is pushed by the plunger.
Disconnect
Turn
Pin
Hook
A93972
Plunger
Push
Turn
51.
52.
53.
54.
55.
56.
57.
58.
59.
60.
61.
A93973
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-79 )
INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSY
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSY (See page 51-8 )
INSTALL GENERATOR ASSY (See page 19-16 )
INSTALL ENGINE WIRE
INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page 14-5 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET NO.2 RH
Torque: 52 N⋅m (531 kgf⋅cm, 38 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
Torque: 64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD W/BRACKET (See page 14-24 )
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (See page 15-2 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2570
14-78
ENGINE MECHANICAL
62.
63.
64.
-
CHAIN (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL HOOD SUB-ASSY
Torque: 13 N⋅m (133 kgf⋅cm, 10 ft⋅lbf)
ADD ENGINE OIL
CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2571
14-121
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
ENGINE (3MZ-FE)
ENGINE (3MZ-FE)
141PF-02
INSPECTION
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-20 )
INSPECT ENGINE OIL
INSPECT BATTERY (See page 19-36 )
INSPECT AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUB-ASSY
INSPECT SPARK PLUG (See page 18-9 )
6.
(a)
A87786
INSPECT V-RIBBED BELT
Using a belt tension gauge, check the belt tension.
Belt tension gauge:
DENSO BTG-20 (95506-00020)
Borroughs No. BT-33-73F
Drive belt tension:
Item
Specified Condition
Cooler compressor to crankshaft pulley
New belt
143 to 165 lbf
Cooler compressor to crankshaft pulley
Used belt
80 to 132 lbf
Vane pump
New belt
132 to 154 lbf
Vane pump
Used belt
55 to 88 lbf
HINT:
CORRECT
INCORRECT
A87787
7.
(a)
(b)
Hand-held Tester
After installing the drive belt, check that it fits properly in
the ribbed grooves. Check that the belt has not slipped
out of the groove on the bottom of the crank pulley with
your hand.
”New belt” is a belt which has been used for less than 5
minutes on a running engine.
”Used belt” is a belt which has been used on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
After installing a new belt, run the engine for approximately 5 minutes and then recheck the tension.
INSPECT IGNITION TIMING
Warm up the engine.
When using the hand-held tester:
Check the ignition timing.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Enter DATA LIST MODE on the hand-held tester.
Ignition timing: 8 to 12 BTDC @ idle
HINT:
Please refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
A80020
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2614
14-122
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
ENGINE (3MZ-FE)
(c)
CG
DLC3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 1213141516
TC
A82779
When not using the hand-held tester:
Check the ignition timing.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals 13 (TC) and 4 (CG)
of the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
NOTICE:
Confirm the terminal numbers before connecting
them. Connection with a wrong terminal can damage
the engine.
Turn off all electrical systems before connecting the
terminals.
Perform this inspection after the cooling fan motor is
turned off.
(2) Remove the V-bank cover (see page 14-149 ).
(3)
(4)
Tester Terminal
Black Lead Wire
A82935
Hand-held Tester
A80020
Pull out the black lead wire harness as shown in the
illustration.
Connect the tester terminal of the timing light to the
engine.
NOTICE:
Use a timing light which detects the first signal.
(5) Check the ignition timing at idle.
Ignition timing: 8 to 12 BTDC @ idle
NOTICE:
When checking the ignition timing, the transmission
should be in the neutral position.
HINT:
Run the engine at 1,000 to 1,300 rpm for 5 seconds, and then
check that the engine rpm returns to idle speed.
(6) Remove the SST from the DLC3.
(7) Check the ignition timing at idle.
Ignition timing: 7 to 24 BTDC @ idle
(8) Confirm that the ignition timing moves to the advanced angle side when the engine rpm is increased.
(9) Remove the timing light.
8.
INSPECT ENGINE IDLE SPEED
(a) Warm up the engine.
(b)
When using the hand-held tester:
Check the idle speed.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Enter DATA LIST MODE on the hand-held tester.
Idle speed: 650 to 750 rpm
NOTICE:
When checking the idle speed, the transmission
should be in the neutral position.
Check the idle speed with the cooling fan off.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2615
14-123
ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE (3MZ-FE)
Switch off all accessories and air conditioning before
connecting the hand-held tester.
HINT:
Please refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(c) When not using the hand-held tester:
Check the idle speed.
(1) Using SST, connect tachometer tester probe to terminal 9 (TAC) of the DLC3.
SST 09843-18030
(2) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed: 650 to 750 rpm
DLC3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 1213141516
TAC
-
A82779
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
INSPECT COMPRESSION
Warm up and stop the engine.
Disconnect the injector connectors.
Remove the intake air surge tank (see page 10-20 ).
Remove the 6 ignition coils.
Remove the 6 spark plugs.
(f)
P19471
Check the cylinder compression pressure.
SST 09992-00500
(1) Insert a compression gauge into the spark plug
hole.
(2) Fully open the throttle.
(3) While cranking the engine, measure the compression pressure.
Compression pressure:
1.5 MPa (15.3 kgf/cm2, 218 psi)
Minimum pressure: 1.0 MPa (10.2 kgf/cm2, 145 psi)
Difference between each cylinder:
100 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 15 psi)
NOTICE:
Always use a fully charged battery to obtain engine
speed of 250 rpm or more.
Check other cylinder’s compression pressure in the
same way.
This measurement must be done as quickly as possible.
(4) If the cylinder compression is low, pour a small
amount of engine oil into the cylinder through the
spark plug hole and inspect again.
HINT:
If adding oil increases the compression, the piston rings
and/or cylinder bore may be worn or damaged.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2616
14-124
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
ENGINE (3MZ-FE)
If pressure stays low, a valve may be stuck or seated improperly, or there may be leakage in the gasket.
10. INSPECT CO/HC
(a) Start the engine.
(b) Rev the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 180 seconds.
(c) Insert CO/HC meter testing probe at least 40 cm (1.3 ft) into the tailpipe during idling.
(d) Check CO/HC concentration at idle and/or 2,500 rpm.
HINT:
Check regulations and restrictions in your area when performing 2 mode CO/CH concentration testing (engine check at both idle speed and at 2,500 rpm).
If the CO/HC concentration does not comply with regulations, troubleshoot in the order given below.
(1) Check A/F sensor operation (see page 05-649 ).
(2) See the table below for possible causes, and then inspect and repair.
CO
Normal
Low
High
HC
High
High
High
Problems
Causes
Rough idle
1. Faulty ignitions:
Incorrect timing
Fouled, shorted or improperly gapped plugs
2. Incorrect valve clearance
3. Leaks in intake and exhaust valves
4. Leaks in cylinders
Rough idle
(fluctuating HC reading)
1. Vacuum leaks:
PCV hoses
Intake manifold
Throttle body
Brake booster line
2. Lean mixture causing misfire
Rough idle
(black smoke from exhaust)
1. Restricted air filter
2. Plugged PCV valve
3. Faulty SFI system:
Faulty fuel pressure regulator
Defective ECT sensor
Defective MAF meter
Faulty ECM
Faulty injectors
Faulty throttle position sensor
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2617
14-125
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
DRIVE BELT (3MZ-FE)
DRIVE BELT (3MZ-FE)
141PG-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE V (COOLER COMPRESSOR
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
Loosen bolts A and B.
Loosen adjusting bolt C and remove the belt.
5.
(a)
REMOVE VANE PUMP V BELT
Loosen bolts A and B, and remove the belt.
6.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL VANE PUMP V BELT
Install the belt on each pulley.
Using a bar, adjust the belt tension and tighten bolt B.
Torque: 43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
Tighten bolt A.
Torque: 43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
A
C
TO
B
A62387
A
B
A62382
A
(c)
B
A62382
7.
A
C
B
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
Install the belt on each pulley.
Tighten adjusting bolt C, and adjust the belt tension.
First tighten bolt A, and then B.
Torque:
58 N⋅m (591 kgf⋅cm, 43 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
A62387
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2618
14-126
ENGINE MECHANICAL
8.
9.
-
DRIVE BELT (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION (See page 14-121 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2619
14-127
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
VALVE CLEARANCE (3MZ-FE)
VALVE CLEARANCE (3MZ-FE)
141PH-01
ADJUSTMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
REMOVE V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE RADIATOR HOSE INLET
REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSY
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY LH (See page 14-173 )
17.
(a)
INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align the timing notch with
timing mark 0 of the No. 1 timing belt cover.
(b) Check that the valve lifters on the No. 1 (IN and EX) are
both loose.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360) and align the mark
as above.
P18805
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2620
14-128
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c)
RH Bank
3 3
EX
IN
-
Check the valves indicated in the illustration on the left.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
0.15 to 0.25 mm (0.006 to 0.010 in.)
Exhaust
0.25 to 0.35 mm (0.010 to 0.014 in.)
(2)
1 1
Front
LH Bank
VALVE CLEARANCE (3MZ-FE)
6 6
Record valve clearance measurements that are out
of the specified range. These measurements will be
used later to determine the size of the adjustment
shim to be installed.
IN
EX
2 2
A78666
(d)
RH Bank
5 5
EX
IN
3 3
LH Bank
Turn the crankshaft 2/3 of a revolution (240), and check
the valves indicated in the illustration on the left.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
0.15 to 0.25 mm (0.006 to 0.010 in.)
Exhaust
0.25 to 0.35 mm (0.010 to 0.014 in.)
(2)
Front
2 2
Record valve clearance measurements that are out
of the specified range. These measurements will be
used later to determine the size of the adjustment
shim to be installed.
IN
EX
4 4
A78667
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2621
14-129
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(e)
RH Bank
1 1
EX
IN
Front
4 4
VALVE CLEARANCE (3MZ-FE)
Turn the crankshaft 2/3 of a revolution (240), and check
the valves indicated in the illustration on the left.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
0.15 to 0.25 mm (0.006 to 0.010 in.)
Exhaust
0.25 to 0.35 mm (0.010 to 0.014 in.)
(2)
5 5
LH Bank
-
Record valve clearance measurements that are out
of the specified range. These measurements will be
used later to determine the size of the adjustment
shim to be installed.
IN
EX
6 6
A78668
Upward
18.
(a)
(b)
ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
Turn the camshaft so that the cam lobe faces upward.
Turn the valve lifter with a screwdriver so that the notches
are perpendicular to the camshaft.
(c)
Using SST (A), press down the valve lifter and place SST
(B) between the camshaft and valve lifter. Remove SST
(A).
SST 09248-55040 (09248-05410, 09248-05420)
Notch
A78669
Front of No. 1 and No. 2 Cylinders
SST (A)
HINT:
SST (B)
7
Apply SST (B) at a slight angle on the side marked with
”9” or ”7” at the position shown in the illustration.
When SST (B) is inserted too deeply, it will get pinched by
the shim. To prevent it from being stuck, insert it gently
from the intake side at a slight angle.
Others
SST (A)
SST (B)
9
A78670
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2622
14-130
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
VALVE CLEARANCE (3MZ-FE)
(d)
Using a small screwdriver and magnetic finger, remove
the adjusting shim.
(e)
Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the removed shim.
Calculate the thickness of a new shim so that the valve
clearance comes within the specified value.
SST (B)
Magnetic Finger
A78671
(f)
EM0494
(g)
A
Thickness of new shim
B
Thickness of used shim
C
Measured valve clearance
Specified value (Cold):
Intake A = B + (C - 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.))
Exhaust A = B + (C - 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.))
Select a new shim with a thickness as close as possible
to the calculated values.
EXAMPLE (Intake):
Measured valve clearance = 0.45 mm (0.0177 in.)
0.45 mm (0.0177 in.) - 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.) = 0.25 mm (0.0098 in.)
(Measured - Specification = Excess clearance)
Used shim measurement = 2.80 mm (0.1102 in.)
0.25 mm (0.0098 in.) + 2.80 mm (0.1102 in.) = 3.05 mm (0.1201 in.)
(Excess clearance + Used shim = Ideal new shim)
Closest new shim = 3.05 mm (0.1201 in.)
Select No. 12 shim
HINT:
Shims are available in 17 sizes in increments of 0.05 mm
(0.0020 in.), from 2.50 mm (0.0984 in.) to 3.30 mm
(0.1299 in.).
Refer to adjusting shim selection chart on the following 2
pages.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2623
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Intake)
Installed shim thickness
mm (in.)
Measured clearance
mm (in.)
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
Author:
Shim
No.
Thickness
Shim
No.
mm (in.)
Thickness
VALVE CLEARANCE (3MZ-FE)
New shim thickness
Date:
HINT:
A shim’s thickness is written on its face in
millimeters.
14-131
V00719
2624
Intake valve clearance (Cold):
0.15 to 0.25 mm (0.006 to 0.010 in.)
EXAMPLE:
The 2.800 mm (0.1102 in.) shim is installed, and the measured
clearance is 0.450 mm (0.0177 in.). Replace the 2.800 mm
(0.1102 in.) shim with a new No. 12 shim.
14-132
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Exhaust)
Installed shim thickness
mm (in.)
Measured clearance
mm (in.)
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
Author:
Shim
No.
Thickness
Shim
No.
mm (in.)
Thickness
Date:
V00720
2625
Exhaust valve clearance (Cold):
0.25 to 0.35 mm (0.010 to 0.014 in.)
EXAMPLE:
The 2.800 mm (0.1102 in.) shim is installed, and the measured
clearance is 0.450 mm (0.0177 in.). Replace the 2.800 mm
(0.1102 in.) shim with a new No. 10 shim.
HINT:
A shim’s thickness is written on its face in
millimeters.
VALVE CLEARANCE (3MZ-FE)
New shim thickness
14-133
ENGINE MECHANICAL
SST (A)
(h)
(i)
SST (B)
(j)
-
VALVE CLEARANCE (3MZ-FE)
Place a new adjusting shim on the valve lifter with the imprinted number facing down.
Press down the valve lifter with SST (A), and remove SST
(B).
SST 09248-55040 (09248-05410, 09248-05420)
Recheck the valve clearance.
A78672
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY LH (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSY
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL RADIATOR HOSE INLET
INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
CONNECT VACUUM HOSES (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-20 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2626
14-134
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
141PI-02
COMPONENTS
Front Fender Apron Seal RH
Front Fender Apron Seal LH
Front Fender Splash Shield Sub-assy RH
Front Fender Splash Shield Sub-assy LH
Engine Under Cover No. 1
A91354
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2627
14-135
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Front Wiper Arm LH
Front Wiper Arm RH
24 (245, 18)
Cowl Top Ventilator Louver Sub-assy
7.0 (71, 62 in.⋅lbf)
Windshield Wiper Link Assy
Cowl Panel Sub-assy
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A91356
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2628
14-136
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Front Suspension Brace
Sub-assy Upper Center
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Battery Clamp Sub-assy
Air Cleaner Cap
Sub-assy
Air Cleaner Filter
Element Sub-assy
V-Bank Cover Sub-assy
5.0 (51, 44 in.⋅lbf)
Battery
Battery Tray
Air Cleaner Case
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A91357
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2629
14-137
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Engine Moving Control Rod
V-Belt No. 1
64 (653, 47)
23 (235, 17)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
58 (591, 43)
Generator Bracket No. 2
Condenser
28 (286, 21)
10 (102, 7)
43 (438, 32)
Engine Mounting Stay No. 2 RH
Generator Assy
18 (184, 13)
Generator Belt Adjusting Bar
Oil Reservoir to Pump
Hose No. 1
Union to Check Valve Hose
Fuel Vapor Feed Hose
Heater Outlet Water Hose
Radiator Hose Outlet
Heater Inlet Water Hose
Fuel Pipe Sub-assy No. 1
Fuel Pipe Clamp
Steering Gear Outlet
Return Tube
Radiator Hose Inlet
Transmission Control
Cable Assy
Oil Cooler Inlet Tube No. 1
Oil Cooler Outlet Tube No. 1
Fan Belt Adjusting
Bar Bracket
15 (152, 11)
25 (255, 18)
Compressor and
Magnetic Clutch
26 (265, 19)
25 (255, 18)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A91358
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2630
14-138
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Steering Intermediate
Shaft Sub-assy
35 (357, 26)
35 (357, 26)
Front Stabilizer Link Assy LH
Power Steering Link Assy
Tie Rod End Sub-assy LH
49 (500, 36)
74 (755, 55)
Front Drive Shaft Assy LH
Cotter Pin
Speed Sensor Front LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Front Axle Hub LH Nut
Front Suspension Arm
Sub-assy Lower No. 1 LH
294 (2,998, 217)
127 (1,295, 217)
74 (755, 55)
Exhaust Pipe Support Bracket No. 1
Gasket
Gasket
Exhaust Pipe Sub-assy Front No. 3
21 (214, 15)
4WD:
Propeller Shaft Assy
56 (571, 41)
56 (571, 41)
Gasket
48 (490, 35)
Exhaust Pipe Assy Front
56 (571, 41)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A91359
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2631
14-139
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Exhaust Manifold Heat Insulator No. 1
Vane Pump V-Belt
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
43 (438, 32)
49 (500, 36)
Exhaust Manifold
Converter Sub-assy
×6
Vane Pump Assy
95 (969, 70)
34 (347, 25)
Gasket
Manifold Stay
87 (887, 64)
95 (969, 70)
Stabilizer Bar Front
29 (296, 21)
75 (765, 55)
Front Frame Assy
70 (714, 52)
Power Steering
Link Assy
Front Side Rail Plate
Sub-assy RH
Front Suspension
Member Brace Rear RH
85 (867, 63)
Front Suspension
Member Brace Rear LH
32 (326, 24)
Front Side Rail Plate
Sub-assy LH
85 (867, 63)
32 (326, 24)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A91361
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2632
14-140
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
69 (704, 51)
4WD:
Front Drive Shaft Assy RH
Transfer Assy
Snap Ring
34 (347, 25)
64 (653, 47)
34 (347, 25)
4WD:
Engine Mounting Bracket RR
Transfer Stiffener Plate RH
2WD:
Engine Mounting Bracket RR
2WD:
Front Drive Shaft Assy RH
64 (653, 47)
Snap Ring
Snap Ring
32 (326, 24)
Front Drive Shaft Assy LH
Flywheel Housing
Under Cover
×6
64 (653, 47)
41 (418, 30)
37 (377, 27)
Automatic Transaxle
Assy
8 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
37 (377, 27)
64 (653, 47)
Engine Mounting Bracket FR
Starter Assy
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A91363
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2633
14-141
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Emission Control Valve Set
Engine Hanger No. 1
20 (204, 15)
Emission Control
Valve Bracket
28 (286, 21)
20 (204, 15)
Surge Tank
Stay No. 2
20 (204, 15)
20 (204, 15)
Intake Air Surge Tank
Surge Tank Stay No. 1
28 (286, 21)
Gasket
15 (153, 11)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
15 (153, 11)
15 (153, 11)
15 (153, 11)
Intake Manifold
Water Outlet
Gasket
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Ignition Coil Assy
83 (846, 61)
×8
Drive Plate
Spacer Rear
Drive Plate
Spacer Front
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
Drive Plate & Ring Gear
Sub-assy
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A81803
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2634
14-142
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
20 (204, 15)
Knock Sensor
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Thermostat
32 (326, 24)
Water Inlet
O-Ring
Pump Bracket
Water Inlet Pipe
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
20 (204, 15)
15 (153, 11)
Engine Oil Pressure
Switch Assy
Exhaust Manifold Heat
Insulator No. 2
54 (551, 40)
Gasket
Engine Mounting Bracket RH
58 (591, 43)
Generator Bracket No. 1
×6
49 (500, 36)
25 (255, 18)
Compressor Mounting Bracket No. 1
Exhaust Manifold
Converter Sub-assy
No. 2
Manifold Stay No. 2
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Manifold Converter
Insulator No. 3
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
49 (500, 36)
A91371
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2635
14-143
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Spark Plug
27 (275, 20)
Oil Filler Cap Sub-assy
18 (184, 13)
Ventilation Valve
Sub-assy
Spark Plug
18 (184, 13)
×9
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
×9
Oil Filler Cap
Gasket
Gasket
Gasket
Cylinder Head Cover
Sub-assy
Cylinder Head Cover
Sub-assy LH
Spark Plug Tube Gasket
VVT Sensor
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Spark Plug Tube Gasket
Camshaft Timing Oil
Control Valve Assy
O-Ring
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Camshaft Timing Oil
Control Valve Assy
VVT Sensor
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Oil Level Gage Guide
Oil Level Gage
Sub-assy
O-Ring
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A78304
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2636
14-144
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Timing Belt
Timing Belt No. 2 Cover
Timing Belt Guide No. 2
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Engine Mounting
Bracket RH
220 (2,243, 162)
28 (286, 21)
Timing Belt No. 1 Cover
Crankshaft Pulley
Timing Belt
Tensioner Assy
27 (275, 20)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A78305
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2637
14-145
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Timing Belt No. 3 Cover
Collar
Gasket
Camshaft Timing Pulley
Timing Belt Idler Bracket
Bushing
125 (1,275, 92)
28 (286, 21)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Camshaft Timing Pulley
43 (438, 32)
125 (1,275, 92)
Timing Belt Idler
Sub-assy No. 2
Water Pump Assy
Water Pump Gasket
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Timing Belt Idler Sub-assy No. 1
34 (347, 25)
Crankshaft Timing Pulley
Timing Belt Plate
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
A78306
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2638
14-146
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 4
RH Bank
Camshaft Timing Gear Bolt Washer
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 2
Camshaft Sub Gear
Camshaft Sub Gear
Wave Washer
× 10
16 (163, 12)
Camshaft Sub Gear
Shaft Snap Ring
Camshaft Bearing
Cap No. 1
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 5
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 2
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 3
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 6
No. 2 Camshaft
16 (163, 12)
× 10
150 (1,530, 111)
Camshaft Bearing
Cap No. 2
Camshaft Timing Gear Assy
Camshaft
See page 14-235
1st: 54 (551, 40)
2nd: Turn 90
×8
19 (194, 14)
Gasket
10 (102, 7)
Cylinder Head
Sub-assy
Cylinder Head
Cover Rear
45 (459, 33)
Gasket
Camshaft Setting
Oil Seal
Oil Control
Valve Filter
Cylinder Head
Gasket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A78307
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2639
14-147
ENGINE MECHANICAL
LH Bank
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 5
× 10
16 (163, 12)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 2
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 3
Camshaft Bearing Cap No. 6
Camshaft Sub
Camshaft Timing Gear Assy Gear Wave Washer
150 (1,530, 110)
Camshaft Bearing
Cap No. 2
No. 3 Camshaft
Sub-assy
× 10
Camshaft Bearing
Cap No. 2
Camshaft Bearing
Cap No. 4
Camshaft
Sub Gear
Camshaft Sub
Gear Shaft
Snap Ring
16 (163, 12)
Oil Control
Valve Filter
Camshaft Bearing
Cap No. 1
Gasket
Camshaft Timing
Gear Bolt Washer
No. 4 Camshaft Sub-assy
45 (459, 33)
See page 14-240
×8
1st: 54 (551, 40)
2nd: Turn 90
10 (102, 7)
19 (194, 14)
Cylinder Head LH
Gasket
Camshaft Setting
Oil Seal
Cylinder Head
Cover Rear
Engine Hanger No. 2
20 (204, 15)
Cylinder Head
Gasket No. 2
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A78308
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2640
14-148
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Water Inlet Housing
Engine Rear Oil Seal Retainer
Cylinder Block Sub-assy
20 (204, 15)
Oil Pump Assy
43 (438, 32)
×6
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Engine Rear Oil Seal Retainer
O-Ring
30 (306, 22)
Oil Filter Union
Oil Filter
Sub-assy
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Oil Pan Baffle Plate
Oil Pump Seal
Oil Pan Sub-assy
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
20 (204, 15)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
20 (204, 15)
Gasket
Oil Strainer Sub-assy
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Oil Pan Sub-assy No. 2
Oil Pan Drain Plug
45 (459, 33)
Gasket
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A78309
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2641
14-173
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
141PK-02
OVERHAUL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
REMOVE SPARK PLUG
REMOVE VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY
REMOVE OIL FILLER CAP SUB-ASSY
REMOVE OIL FILLER CAP GASKET
6.
(a)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(a)
(a)
(c)
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY
Remove the 2 engine wire harness clamps.
Remove the 3 nuts and disconnect the engine wire harness.
Remove the 9 bolts and cylinder head cover.
(b)
A78541
7.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER GASKET
8.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY LH
Using an E6 torx socket wrench, remove the 2 bolts and
disconnect the engine wire harness protector.
Remove the 9 bolts and cylinder head cover.
A36719
9.
10.
11.
(a)
(b)
12.
13.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER GASKET NO.2
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
REMOVE VVT SENSOR
Remove the sensor.
Remove the O-ring from the sensor.
REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAGE SUB-ASSY
REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAGE GUIDE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2666
14-174
ENGINE MECHANICAL
14.
(a)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
Using SST, loosen the pulley bolt.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
SST
A78700
(b)
Using SST and the pulley bolt, remove the pulley.
SST 09950- 50013 (09951- 05010, 09952- 05010,
09953-05020, 09954-05031)
NOTICE:
Before using SST, apply lubricating oil to the threads and
tip of the center bolt 150.
SST
A78701
15.
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER
16.
(a)
Clamp
Clamp
(b)
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER
Disconnect the engine wire protector clamps from the timing belt No. 3 cover.
Remove the 5 bolts and timing belt cover.
A05050
17.
18.
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2
19.
(a)
REMOVE TIMING BELT
Set the No. 1 cylinder to TDC/compression.
(1) Temporarily install the crankshaft pulley bolt and
washer to the crankshaft.
(2) Turn the crankshaft clockwise, and align the timing
mark of the crankshaft timing pulley with the oil
pump body.
Turn
A78326
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2667
14-175
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(3)
Check that timing marks of the camshaft timing pulleys and No. 3 timing belt cover are aligned.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360).
(4) Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt.
A05052
(b)
If planning to reuse the timing belt, check that there are
4 installation marks on the timing belt, as shown in the illustration.
(1) If the installation marks have disappeared, put new
installation marks on the timing belt before removing.
A52840
(c)
Approx. 60
Turn
A78327
Set the No. 1 cylinder to approximately 60 BTDC/ compression.
(1) Turn the crankshaft counterclockwise by approximately 60.
NOTICE:
With the timing belt removed:
The crankshaft pulley must be at the correct angle to avoid
damage in later steps. If the crankshaft pulley is at the
wrong angle and the camshaft timing pulley and the camshaft are removed, the piston head and valve head may
come in contact and damaged.
(d) Remove the timing belt tensioner.
NOTICE:
Do not reinstall the tensioner with its plunger extended.
(e)
(3)
(5)
(2)
(4)
(1)
Remove the timing belt in this order.
1st
No. 1 idler pulley
2nd
RH camshaft timing pulley
3rd
No. 2 idler pulley
4th
LH camshaft timing pulley
5th
Water pump pulley
6th
Crankshaft timing pulley
(6)
A78702
20.
(a)
21.
22.
REMOVE TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.1
Using a socket hexagon wrench 10, remove the pivot bolt, timing belt idler No. 1 and plate washer.
REMOVE TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2668
14-176
ENGINE MECHANICAL
RH
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
23.
(a)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Using SST, remove the bolt and RH timing pulley.
SST 09960- 10010 (09962- 01000, 09963- 01000),
09249-63010
(b)
Using SST, remove the bolt and LH timing pulley.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-01000)
SST
A90211
LH
HINT:
Arrange the camshaft timing pulleys (RH and LH sides) so that
they can be returned to the original locations when reassembling.
SST
A90212
24.
(a)
Clamp
Clamp
(b)
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER
Disconnect the 3 engine wire harness clamps from the
timing belt No. 3 cover.
Remove the 6 bolts and the timing belt cover.
Clamp
A05077
25.
REMOVE TIMING BELT IDLER BRACKET
26.
(a)
(b)
(c)
SST
A15128
A32939
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Remove the bolt and the timing belt plate.
Install the pulley bolt to the crankshaft.
Using SST, remove the crankshaft timing pulley.
SST 09950- 50013 (09951- 05010, 09952- 05010,
09953-05020, 09954-05011)
NOTICE:
Do not scratch the sensor part of the crankshaft timing pulley.
Before using SST, apply lubricating oil to the threads
and tip of the center bolt 150.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2669
14-177
ENGINE MECHANICAL
27.
(a)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE WATER PUMP ASSY
Remove the 3 bolts and 3 nuts, then remove the water
pump and the gasket.
A78535
28. REMOVE CAMSHAFT
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be kept level while it is being removed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, damage to the cylinder head or
to the camshaft may result. To avoid this, the following
steps must be carried out.
(a)
Align the camshaft drive and driven gear’s timing marks
(2 dot marks each) by turning the camshaft with a wrench.
(b)
Secure the exhaust camshaft sub gear to the main gear
with a service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Align
A78706
Main Gear
Sub Gear
Service Bolt
A78707
Thread diameter
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 to 20 mm
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
HINT:
When removing the camshaft, make certain that the torsional
spring force of the sub gear has been eliminated by installation
of the service bolt.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2670
14-178
ENGINE MECHANICAL
10
6
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(c)
2
8
1
5
4
9
7
3
Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap bolts in
the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 5
bearing caps and the camshaft.
NOTICE:
Do not pry out the camshaft.
Be careful not to damage the portion of the cylinder
head receiving the shaft thrust.
A78708
5
29.
(a)
1
9
7
2
6
3
10
8
4
A78709
REMOVE NO.2 CAMSHAFT
Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap bolts in
the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 5
bearing caps and the No. 2 camshaft.
NOTICE:
Do not pry out the camshaft.
Be careful not to damage the portion of the cylinder
head receiving the shaft thrust.
(b) Remove the oil seal from the No. 2 camshaft.
30. REMOVE NO.3 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be kept level while it is being removed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, damage to the cylinder head or
to the camshaft may result. To avoid this, the following
steps should be carried out.
(a)
Align
Align the camshaft drive and driven gear’s timing marks
(1 dot mark each) by turning the camshaft with a wrench.
A78710
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2671
14-179
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b)
Service Bolt
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Secure the exhaust camshaft sub gear to the main gear
with a service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Thread diameter
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 to 20 mm
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
Main Gear
Sub Gear
A78711
(c)
1
5
2
9
6
7
10
8
3
HINT:
When removing the camshaft, make certain that the torsional
spring force of the sub gear has been eliminated by installation
of the service bolt.
4
Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap bolts in
the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 5
bearing caps and the No. 3 camshaft.
NOTICE:
Do not pry out the camshaft.
Be careful not to damage the portion of the cylinder
head receiving the shaft thrust.
A78712
6
31.
(a)
2
10
1
8
5
9
4
7
3
A78713
REMOVE NO.4 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSY
Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap bolts in
the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 5
bearing caps and the No. 4 camshaft.
NOTICE:
Do not pry out the camshaft.
Be careful not to damage the portion of the cylinder
head receiving the shaft thrust.
(b) Remove the oil seal from the No. 4 camshaft.
32.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
Clamp the camshaft in a vise on the hexagonal lobe.
Check that the VVT-i does not turn.
A05739
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2672
14-180
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(c)
Convex Portion
A78714
Cover all the oil ports with vinyl tape except the port on the
advanced angle side (nearest to the convex portion)
shown in the illustration.
(d) Using an air gun, apply about 100 kPa (1 kgf/cm2, 14 psi)
of air pressure to the port on the advanced angle side.
NOTICE:
Some oil will spill out. Contain the oil with a shop rag.
HINT:
This operation releases the lock pin for the extreme retarded
angle lock.
(e) Under the condition above, check that the VVT-i can be
turned by hand to the advanced angle side, the direction
of the white arrow in the illustration.
Standard: Must turn
HINT:
The VVT-i will turn to the advanced angle side without applying
force by hand depending on the force of the air pressure applied. Also, if applying pressure to the oil path is difficult as a result of air leakage from the port, the lock-pin may be difficult to
release.
(f)
Check that the VVT-i moves freely within a 30 range.
Avoid moving the VVT-i unit to the extreme retarded
angle position as the lock-pin will re-engage.
Standard: Smooth movable range is about 30
(g) Turn the VVT-i by hand and lock it at the extreme retarded angle position.
33. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
NOTICE:
Do not remove or install the timing gear (VVT-i) unless you
are replacing the VVT-i or the camshaft.
(a) Clamp the camshaft in a vise on the hexagonal lobe.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the camshaft.
A05739
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2673
14-181
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(b)
A05740
Using a 46 mm socket wrench, remove the lock nut by
turning it clockwise.
NOTICE:
Remove it with the lock-pin engaged and locked at
the extreme retarded angle position.
The lock nut has LH threads.
Only use the socket wrench. Other tools will deform
the cam angle rotor.
(c) Remove the timing gear (VVT-i).
NOTICE:
Never remove the 3 bolts on the gear.
If it is difficult to remove the VVT-i, tap it lightly using a plasticfaced hammer and then remove it.
34. REMOVE CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
(a) Clamp the camshaft in a vise on the hexagonal lobe.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
P12596
(b)
Using SST, turn the sub gear counterclockwise and remove the service bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
(c)
(d)
Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
Remove the wave washer, camshaft sub gear and camshaft gear bolt washer.
SST
A78715
Snap Ring Pliers
HINT:
Arrange the camshaft sub gears and gear bolt washers (RH and
LH sides) so that they can be returned to their original location
when reassembled.
A52353
35.
36.
REMOVE ENGINE HANGER NO.2
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER REAR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2674
14-182
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
37.
(a)
REMOVE OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
Remove the plug, gasket and valve filter.
38.
(a)
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSY
Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, remove the hexagon
bolt.
A05275
Front
A78716
(b)
Uniformly loosen the 8 cylinder head bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 8 cylinder
head bolts and plate washers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop washers into the cylinder head.
Head warpage or cracking could result from removing bolts in an incorrect order.
Front
2
7
5
3
4
6
8
1
A78717
39.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
40.
(a)
Front
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD LH
Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, remove the hexagon
bolt.
A78718
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2675
14-183
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(b)
Uniformly loosen the 8 cylinder head bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 8 cylinder
head bolts and plate washers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop washers into the cylinder head.
Head warpage or cracking could result from removing bolts in an incorrect order.
Front
4
6
8
1
2
7
5
3
A78719
41.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD GASKET NO.2
8
2
42.
(a)
REMOVE WATER INLET HOUSING
Uniformly loosen and remove the 8 bolts and 2 nuts in the
sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the water inlet housing.
43.
(a)
REMOVE OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY
Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228-07501
Using a socket hexagon wrench 12, remove the oil filter
union.
10
5
3
4
6
7
9
1
A78314
SST
(b)
B06486
44.
REMOVE OIL PAN DRAIN PLUG
45.
(a)
REMOVE OIL PAN SUB-ASSY NO.2
Remove the 10 bolts and 2 nuts.
A36750
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2676
14-184
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(b)
SST
SST
A00019
46.
(a)
Insert the blade of SST between the oil pan No. 1 and oil
pan No. 2. Cut through the sealer and remove the oil pan
No. 2.
SST 09032-00100
NOTICE:
Do not damage the contact surface of oil pan No. 1
and oil pan No. 2.
Do not damage the flange portion of the oil pan No. 2
during removal.
REMOVE OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSY
Remove the bolt and 2 nuts. Then remove the oil strainer and the gasket.
47.
(a)
REMOVE OIL PAN SUB-ASSY
Uniformly loosen and remove the 15 bolts and 2 nuts, as
shown in the illustration.
B04136
(b)
Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pan by prying between the cylinder block and the oil pan.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the oil pan
and cylinder block.
B04137
48.
REMOVE OIL PAN BAFFLE PLATE
49.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
Uniformly loosen and remove the 6 bolts.
Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal retainer by prying
between the oil seal retainer and the main bearing cap.
P12508
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2677
14-185
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
50.
(a)
REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
Using a screwdriver and a hammer, tap out the oil seal.
51.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE OIL PUMP ASSY
Remove the 9 bolts.
Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pump by prying between the oil pump and the main bearing cap.
Remove the O-ring.
52.
(a)
REMOVE OIL PUMP SEAL
Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
P12589
A51990
A62375
53.
(a)
REMOVE SPARK PLUG TUBE GASKET
Bend up the tab on the ventilation baffle plate which prevents the gasket from slipping out.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the baffle plate of the cylinder
head cover.
(b) Using a screwdriver and a hammer, tap out the gasket.
A05245
(c) Using needle-nose pliers, pry out the gasket.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head cover.
A05243
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2678
14-186
ENGINE MECHANICAL
EM3336
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
54. INSPECT TIMING BELT
NOTICE:
Do not bend, twist or turn the timing belt inside out.
Do not allow the timing belt to come into contact with
oil, water or steam.
Do not utilize timing belt tension when installing or removing the mounting bolt of the camshaft timing
pulley.
Check the belt for any defects, as shown in the illustrations.
Also, check these points below.
(a) If there is premature parting:
Check for proper installation.
Check the timing cover gasket for no damage and
proper installation.
(b) If the belt teeth are cracked or damaged, check to see if
either camshaft is locked.
(c) If there is noticeable wear or cracks on the belt, check to
see if there are nicks on the side of the idler pulley lock
and water pump.
(d) If there is wear or damage on only one side of the belt,
check the belt guide and the alignment of each pulley.
(e) If there is noticeable wear on the belt teeth:
Check the timing cover for damage.
Check that the gasket has been installed correctly.
Check for foreign objects on the pulley teeth.
If there is any doubt about the belt condition, replace the timing
belt.
55.
(a)
INSPECT CAMSHAFT
Inspect the camshaft for runout.
(1) Place the camshaft on V-blocks.
(2) Using a dial indicator, measure the runout at the
center journal.
Maximum circle runout: 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the runout is greater than the maximum, replace the camshaft.
EM1628
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2679
14-187
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Inspect the cam lobes.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the cam lobe height.
Standard cam lobe height:
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
43.132 to 43.232 mm (1.6981 to 1.7020 in.)
Exhaust
43.010 to 43.110 mm (1.6933 to 1.6972 in.)
Minimum cam lobe height:
A51428
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
42.98 mm (1.6921 in.)
Exhaust
42.86 mm (1.6874 in.)
If the cam lobe height is less than the minimum, replace the
camshaft.
(c)
Inspect the camshaft journals.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the journal diameter.
Journal diameter:
26.959 to 26.975 mm (1.0614 to 1.0620 in.)
If the journal diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance.
A51429
56.
(a)
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD SET BOLT
Using a vernier caliper, measure the tension portion diameter of the bolt.
Standard outside diameter:
8.95 to 9.05 mm (0.3524 to 0.3563 in.)
Minimum outside diameter: 8.75 mm (0.3445 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the bolt.
Tension Portion
A78721
57.
(a)
SST
(b)
(c)
INSTALL SPARK PLUG TUBE GASKET
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new gasket until its surface is flush with the upper edge of the cylinder head cover.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00430), 09950- 70010
(09951-07100)
Return the ventilation plate tab to its original position.
Apply a light coat of MP grease to the gasket lip.
A78722
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2680
14-188
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
58.
(a)
SST
A78723
INSTALL ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST 09223-15030, 09950-70010 (09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to tap the oil seal at an angle.
Keep the gap between the rear oil seal retainer edge
and the oil seal free of foreign matter.
(b) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
59.
(a)
Seal Width: 2 to 3 mm
A
INSTALL ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
Remove any old packing material from the contact surface.
(b)
A
B
B
A78724
Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (seal width: 2 to
3 mm (0.08 to 0.12 in.)), as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Install the oil seal retainer within 3 minutes after applying seal packing.
Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at least 2
hours after installing.
(c) Install the oil seal retainer. Tighten the 6 bolts uniformly.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
60.
(a)
SST
A78754
INSTALL OIL PUMP SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
SST 09223-00010
NOTICE:
Be careful not to tap the oil seal at an angle.
Keep the gap between the oil pump body edge and the
oil seal free of foreign matter.
(b) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
61.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL OIL PUMP ASSY
Remove any old packing material from the contact surface.
Apply a light coat of engine oil to a new O-ring and place
it on the cylinder block.
A36784
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2681
14-189
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(c)
Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (seal width: 2 to
3 mm (0.08 to 0.12 in.)), as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Apply seal packing to the inner side of the bolt holes.
Install the oil pump within 3 minutes after applying
seal packing.
Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at least 2
hours after installing the oil pump.
B
A
C
Seal Packing
A
Seal Width:
2 to 3 mm
B
C
A78725
(d)
Align the key of the oil pump drive gear with the keyway
located on the crankshaft, and slide the oil pump into
place.
(e)
Install the oil pump with the 9 bolts. Tighten the bolts uniformly in several steps.
Torque:
8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf) for bolt A
20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf) for bolt C
A36785
A
B
C
A
A
B
A
A
A
A51990
62.
INSTALL OIL PAN BAFFLE PLATE
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2682
14-190
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
63.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL OIL PAN SUB-ASSY
Remove any old seal packing from the contact surface.
Apply
a continuous bead of seal packing (seal width: 3 to
Region ”X”
Region ”Y”
4 mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)), as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Apply seal packing to the outer side of the bolt holes
in region ”X”.
Apply seal packing to the inner side of the bolt holes
in region ”Y”.
B
A
Install the oil pan within 3 minutes after applying seal
packing.
Seal Packing
B
A
Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at least 2
hours after installing.
(c) Install the oil pan No. 1 with the 15 bolts and 2 nuts. Tighten the bolts uniformly in several steps.
Seal Width:
Torque:
3 to 4 mm
8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf) for 10 mm head
A78726
20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf) for 12 mm head
64. INSTALL OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSY
(a) Install a new gasket and the oil strainer with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
65.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL OIL PAN SUB-ASSY NO.2
Remove any old seal packing from the contact surface.
Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (seal width: 4 to
5 mm (0.16 to 0.20 in.)), as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Apply seal packing to the inner side of the bolt holes.
Install the oil pan within 3 minutes after applying seal
packing.
Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at least 2
hours after installing.
(c) Install the oil pan No. 2 with the 10 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Seal Packing
A
A
B
Seal Width:
4 to 5 mm
B
A78727
66.
(a)
INSTALL OIL PAN DRAIN PLUG
Install the drain plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 45 N⋅m (459 kgf⋅cm, 33 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2683
14-191
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Additional
3/4 Turn
A78747
Seal Width: 3 to 5 mm
Seal Packing
A78728
INSTALL OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY
Using a socket hexagon wrench 12, install the oil filter
union.
Torque: 30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Check and clean the oil filter installation surface.
(c) Apply clean engine oil to the gasket of a new oil filter.
(d) Lightly screw the oil filter into place, and tighten it until the
gasket contacts the seat.
(e) Using SST, tighten it an additional 3/4 turn.
SST 09228-07501
68. INSTALL WATER INLET HOUSING
(a) Remove any old packing material from the contact surface.
(b) Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (seal width: 3 to
5 mm (0.12 to 0.20 in.)) as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00100 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Install the water inlet housing within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing.
Do not expose the seal to coolant for at least 2 hours
after installing.
(c)
9
1
6
8
5
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
67.
(a)
SST
3
-
Install the water inlet housing with the 8 bolts and 2 nuts.
Uniformly tighten the bolts and nuts in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
7
2
4
10
A78314
69.
(a)
Front
A78324
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
Place a new cylinder head gasket on the cylinder block
with the R mark upside down, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Make sure the cylinder head gasket is facing in the
correct direction.
Place the cylinder head on the gasket carefully in order not to damage the gasket at the bottom part of the
head.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2684
14-192
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
70. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 successive
steps.
(a)
Front
7
2
4
6
5
3
1
8
(b)
(c)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads of the cylinder head bolts.
Install the plate washers to the cylinder head bolts.
Uniformly install and tighten the 8 cylinder head bolts in
the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 54 N⋅m (550 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
A78717
(d)
(e)
90
(f)
Front
Mark the front side of each cylinder head bolt head with
paint, as shown in the illustration.
Retighten the cylinder head bolts by 90 in the same sequence as step (c).
Check that each painted mark is now at a 90 angle to the
front.
Painted mark
A78730
(g)
Front
Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, install the hexagon
bolt.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
A78716
71.
(a)
Front
A78325
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD GASKET NO.2
Place a new cylinder head gasket on the cylinder block
with the L mark, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Make sure the cylinder head gasket is facing in the
correct direction.
Place the cylinder head on the gasket carefully in order not to damage the gasket at the bottom part of the
head.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2685
14-193
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
72. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD LH
NOTICE:
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 successive
steps.
(a)
Front
5
3
1
8
7
2
4
6
(b)
(c)
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the cylinder head bolts.
Install the plate washers to the cylinder head bolts.
Uniformly install and tighten the 8 cylinder head bolts in
the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 54 N⋅m (550 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
A78719
(d)
(e)
90
(f)
Front
Mark the front side of each cylinder head bolt head with
paint, as shown in the illustration.
Retighten the cylinder head bolts by 90 in the same sequence as step (c).
Check that each painted mark is now at a 90 angle to the
front.
Painted mark
A78730
(g)
Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, install the hexagon
bolt.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
73.
(a)
INSTALL OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
Check that no foreign matter is on the mesh part of the filter.
Assemble the valve filter and the plug.
Install a new gasket and the plug.
Torque: 45 N⋅m (459 kgf⋅cm, 33 ft⋅lbf)
Front
A78718
(b)
(c)
A05418
74.
(a)
75.
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER REAR
Install a new gasket and the rear cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE HANGER NO.2
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2686
14-194
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
76. INSTALL CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
(a) Clamp the camshaft in a vise on the hexagonal lobe.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
P12595
(b)
Wave Washer
Camshaft
Sub Gear
Install the camshaft gear bolt washer and the camshaft
sub gear.
HINT:
Attach the pins on the gears to the gear bolt washer ends.
(c) Install the wave washer.
Camshaft Gear
Bolt Washer
A78732
(d)
Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
Snap Ring Pliers
A52353
(e)
SST
Main Gear
Sub Gear
A78733
Using SST, align the holes of the camshaft main gear and
sub gear by turning the camshaft sub gear counterclockwise, and temporarily install a service bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
(f)
Align the gear teeth of the main gear and sub gear, and
tighten the service bolt.
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft journals.
HINT:
When installing the camshaft, make certain that the torsional
spring force of the sub gear has been eliminated by installation
of the service bolt.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2687
14-195
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
77.
(a)
Align
A78734
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
Align the alignment pin with the alignment pin groove and
install the VVT-i on the camshaft.
NOTICE:
Install the VVT-i with the lock-pin engaged and locked at
the extreme retarded angle position.
(b) Apply engine oil to the nut, the mounting surface of the
VVT-i and the screw threads.
NOTICE:
Be sure to apply the oil, otherwise the specified
torque cannot be obtained.
New nuts must be used when replacing the VVT-i
unit.
(c)
Using a 46 mm socket wrench, install and tighten a lock
nut by turning it counterclockwise.
Torque: 150 N⋅m (1,530 kgf⋅cm, 111 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
The lock nut has LH threads.
Never use any tools other than the socket wrench.
Other tools will deform the cam angle rotor.
A05738
78. INSTALL NO.2 CAMSHAFT
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be kept level while it is being installed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, damage to the cylinder head or
to the camshaft may result. To avoid this, the following
steps must be carried out.
(a)
90
(b)
Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of
the camshaft.
Place the No. 2 camshaft at a 90 angle of the timing mark
(2 dot marks) on the cylinder head.
A78735
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2688
14-196
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(c) Install the oil seal to the camshaft.
NOTICE:
Do not turn over the oil seal lip.
Insert the oil seal until it stops.
(d) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(e) Remove any old packing material from the contact surface.
Front
A78736
(f)
Apply seal packing to the No. 1 bearing cap, as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the No. 1 bearing cap within 5 minutes after applying seal packing.
Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at least 2
hours after installing.
Seal Packing
A78737
(g)
(h)
Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
(i)
Uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 16 N⋅m (163 kgf⋅cm, 12 ft⋅lbf)
A05283
6
10
2
4
9
8
5
1
3
7
A78738
79. INSTALL CAMSHAFT
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be kept level while it is being installed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, damage to the cylinder head or
to the camshaft may result. To avoid this, the following
steps must be carried out.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2689
14-197
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of
the camshaft.
Align the camshaft drive and driven gear’s timing marks
(2 dot mark each).
Place the camshaft on the cylinder head.
Align
A78739
(d)
(e)
Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
(f)
Uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 16 N⋅m (163 kgf⋅cm, 12 ft⋅lbf)
Remove the service bolt.
A05204
5
9
1
3
10
6
7
(g)
2
4
8
A78740
80. INSTALL NO.4 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be kept level while it is being installed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, damage to the cylinder head or
to the camshaft may result. To avoid this, the following
steps must be carried out.
(a)
(b)
90
(c)
Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of
the camshaft.
Place the No. 4 camshaft at a 90 angle of the timing mark
(1 dot mark) on the cylinder head.
Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
A78741
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2690
14-198
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(d) Install the oil seal to the camshaft.
NOTICE:
Do not turn over the oil seal lip.
Insert the oil seal until it stops.
Front
(e)
Remove any old packing material from the contact surface.
A78742
(f)
Apply seal packing to the No. 1 bearing cap, as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the No. 1 bearing cap within 5 minutes after applying seal packing.
Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at least 2
hours after installing.
Seal Packing
A78737
(g)
(h)
Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
(i)
Uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 16 N⋅m (163 kgf⋅cm, 12 ft⋅lbf)
A05209
9
5
1
10
3
6
7
2
4
8
A78743
81. INSTALL NO.3 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be kept level while it is being installed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, damage to the cylinder head or
to the camshaft may result. To avoid this, the following
steps must be carried out.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2691
14-199
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of
the camshaft.
Align the camshaft drive and driven gear’s timing marks
(1 dot mark each).
Place the camshaft on the cylinder head.
Align
A78744
(d)
(e)
Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
(f)
Uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 16 N⋅m (163 kgf⋅cm, 12 ft⋅lbf)
Remove the service bolt.
A05214
10
6
9
2
4
5
(g)
1
8
3
7
A78745
82.
(a)
INSTALL WATER PUMP ASSY
Install a new gasket and the water pump with the 3 bolts
and 3 nuts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
A78535
83.
(a)
Inward
Sensor
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Align the keyway of the timing pulley with the key located
on the crankshaft and slide the timing pulley into place.
NOTICE:
Do not scratch the sensor area of the crankshaft timing
pulley.
(b) Install the timing belt plate with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
A78746
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2692
14-200
ENGINE MECHANICAL
84.
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL TIMING BELT IDLER BRACKET
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
85. INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER
(a) Visually check for cracks and breaks on the gasket of the
timing belt cover.
HINT:
If water is entering through cracks or breaks in the gasket, repair according to these guidelines: 1) if the crack length is within
2 to 3 cm (0.79 to 1.18 in.), repair with seal packing; or 2) if the
crack length is over 3 cm (1.18 in.), replace the gasket.
(b) If the timing belt cover gasket needs to be repaired, follow
Seal Packing
the procedure below.
Gasket
(1) Repair the cracks and breaks by applying the seal
packing to the damaged area.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
When applying the seal packing, apply it as wide and high
as the gasket.
(c) If the timing belt cover gasket needs to be replaced, follow
A78748
the procedure below.
(1) Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove
the remaining gasket.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the timing belt cover.
(2)
E
F
D
Joining
Line
Joining Portion
Gasket
E
Joining
G Line
Remove the backing paper from a new gasket, and
affix the gasket along the groove of the timing belt
cover, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Affix the gasket in the center of the groove.
At the corners, try to keep the gasket thickness uniform.
Length:
Gasket
D
E
F
G
Specified
Condition
335 mm
(13.19 in.)
180 mm
(7.09 in.)
133 mm
(5.24 in.)
72 mm
(2.83 in.)
(3)
Seal Packing
A78749
If there is a gap on the joint of the gasket, apply seal
packing to close the gap.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
When applying the seal packing, apply it as wide and high
as the gasket.
(d) Install the timing belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2693
14-201
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Front
86.
(a)
Front
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Install the camshaft timing pulley with the belt guide properly oriented and tighten the bolt temporarily.
HINT:
Face the belt guide of the RH timing pulley towards the
front of the engine.
Face the belt guide of the LH timing pulley towards the
rear of the engine.
A78750
(b)
RH
SST
150 mm
A78763
Using SST, tighten the RH pulley bolt.
Torque: 125 N⋅m (1,275 kgf⋅cm, 92 ft⋅lbf)
SST 09960- 10010 (09962- 01000, 09963- 01000),
09249-63010
NOTICE:
The torque specification above is the SST without extension tool specification. Use the special formula to calculate
the SST with extension tool torque specification (see page
01-5 ).
Extended length of SST (09249-63010):
150 mm (5.91 in.)
(c)
LH
Using SST, tighten the LH pulley bolt.
Torque: 125 N⋅m (1,275 kgf⋅cm, 92 ft⋅lbf)
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-01000)
SST
A90212
87.
88.
89.
(a)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
INSTALL TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
Torque: 43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.1
Using a socket hexagon wrench 10, install the plate washer and timing belt idler No. 1 with the pivot
bolt.
Torque: 34 N⋅m (348 kgf⋅cm, 25 ft⋅lbf)
90. INSTALL TIMING BELT
(a) Remove any oil or water on the pulleys, and keep them
clean.
NOTICE:
If there is a trace of water and/or oil on the timing belt,
repair the leakage and install a new timing belt.
Do not use cleaning agents on the pulleys when
cleaning them.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2694
14-202
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(b)
Inspect the idler pulleys.
(1) Check that the idler pulley turns smoothly.
(2) Visually check the sealed portion of the idler pulley
for oil leakage.
If there is any doubt about the idller pulleys condition, replace
the idller pulleys.
(c) Inspect the water pump.
(1) Turn the pulley, and check that the water pump
bearing moves smoothly without any noise.
(2) Visually check the drain hole for coolant leakage.
If there is any doubt about the water pump condition, replace
the water pump.
(d) Temporarily install the crankshaft pulley bolt and washer
to the crankshaft.
(e)
Turn the crankshaft counterclockwise by approximately
60.
NOTICE:
To prevent contacting the piston head and the valve head
from colliding, set the crankshaft pulley at approximately
60 BTDC/compression position.
Approx. 60
Turn
A82349
(f)
Using SST, turn the crankshaft pulley, and align the timing
marks of the timing pulley with the No. 3 timing belt cover.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-01000)
(g)
Turn the crankshaft, and align the timing mark of the
crankshaft timing pulley with the oil pump body.
SST
A78751
A05062
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2695
14-203
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(h)
(i)
(j)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Face the front mark on the timing belt forward.
Align the installation mark on the timing belt with the timing mark of the crankshaft timing pulley.
Align the installation marks on the timing belt with the timing marks of the camshaft timing pulleys.
A52840
(k)
(4)
(2)
(5)
(3)
(6)
Install the timing belt in this order.
1st
Crankshaft timing pulley
2nd
Water pump pulley
3rd
LH camshaft timing pulley
4th
No. 2 idler pulley
5th
RH camshaft timing pulley
6th
No. 1 idler pulley
(1)
A78702
A36238
91. INSTALL TIMING BELT TENSIONER
(a) Set the timing belt tensioner uprightly on the press.
(b) Slowly press in the push rod.
NOTICE:
Do not apply pressure of more than 9.8 kN (1,000 kgf, 2,205
lbf) to the rod.
(c) Align the holes of the push rod and housing, pass a 1.5
mm hexagon wrench through the holes to keep the setting position of the push rod.
(d) Release the press.
(e) Temporarily install the tensioner with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 27 N⋅m (280 kgf⋅cm, 20 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Install the tensioner’s bolts uniformly and evenly. Installing the tensioner at an angle may cause it to malfunction.
(f)
Remove the 1.5 mm hexagon wrench from the tensioner.
(g)
Turn the crankshaft 2 revolutions slowly, and align the timing mark of the crankshaft timing pulley with the oil pump
body.
NOTICE:
Always turn the crankshaft clockwise.
Turn
A78326
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2696
14-204
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(h)
Check that the timing marks of the RH and LH timing pulleys are aligned with the timing marks of the No. 3 timing
belt cover, as shown in the illustration.
If the marks do not align, remove the timing belt and reinstall it.
(i)
Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt.
A05052
92.
(a)
INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2
Install the timing belt guide, facing the cup side toward the
engine front.
A36239
93.
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
94. INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER
(a) Visually check for cracks and breaks on the gasket of the timing belt cover.
If there is a trace that water is entering at the visual check, replace the timing belt cover.
(b) Install the timing belt cover.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
95. INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER
(a) Visually check for cracks and breaks on the gasket of the timing belt cover.
If there is a trace that water is entering at the visual check, replace the timing belt cover.
(b) Install the timing belt cover.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
96.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
Align the keyway of the pulley with the key located on the
crankshaft and slide the pulley into place.
Using SST, install the pulley bolt.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
Torque: 220 N⋅m (2,243 kgf⋅cm, 162 ft⋅lbf)
SST
A78753
97.
(a)
(b)
98.
INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAGE GUIDE
Apply a light coat of engine oil to a new O-ring and install it to the level gage guide.
Install the level gage guide.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAGE SUB-ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2697
14-205
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
99.
INSTALL VVT SENSOR
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
100. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSY
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
101. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE (See page 14-127 )
102. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE (See page 14-127 )
: Seal Packing
Front
A78673
103. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY
(a) Install the gasket to the cylinder head cover.
(b) Apply seal packing to the cylinder head, as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Install the cylinder head cover within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing.
Do not start the engine for at least 2 hours after installing.
(c) Install the cylinder head cover with the 9 bolts. Tighten the
bolts uniformly in several steps.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
104. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY LH
(a) Install the gasket to the cylinder head cover.
(b) Apply seal packing to the cylinder head, as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Front
Install the cylinder head cover within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing.
A78674
Do not start the engine for at least 2 hours after installing.
(c) Install the cylinder head cover with the 9 bolts. Tighten the
bolts uniformly in several steps.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL OIL FILLER CAP SUB-ASSY
INSTALL VENTILATION VALVE SUB-ASSY
Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads.
Adhesive: Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
Install the ventilation valve.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (193 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL SPARK PLUG
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
ADD ENGINE OIL
: Seal Packing
105.
106.
(a)
(b)
107.
108.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2698
14-149
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
141PJ-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
WORK FOR PREVENTING GASOLINE FROM SPILLING OUT (See page 11-35 )
REMOVE FRONT WHEELS
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD SUB-ASSY LH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD SUB-ASSY RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL LH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
DRAIN TRANSFER OIL (4WD TYPE)
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
18.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 3 nuts.
Disconnect the 2 clips, and remove the cover.
A81195
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
REMOVE BATTERY
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
REMOVE AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUB-ASSY
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CASE
REMOVE V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
REMOVE VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
REMOVE GENERATOR ASSY (See page 19-40 )
REMOVE GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
27.
(a)
REMOVE GENERATOR BELT ADJUSTING BAR
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and adjusting bar.
A52889
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2642
14-150
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
28.
(a)
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
Remove the 4 bolts and control rod.
29.
(a)
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
Remove the bolt, mounting stay No. 2 RH and mounting
bracket No. 2 RH.
A90268
A52344
30. SEPARATE COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
(a) Remove the bolt, nut and adjusting bar bracket.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and disconnect the compressor.
HINT:
Hang up the hoses instead of detaching them.
Adjusting Bar Bracket
31.
32.
(a)
A52901
SEPARATE TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY (See page 40-73 )
DISCONNECT UNION TO CHECK VALVE HOSE
Remove the vacuum hose for the brake booster.
33.
(a)
Fuel Pipe
Clamp No. 1
DISCONNECT FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSY NO.1
Remove the fuel pipe clamp.
A60083
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2643
14-151
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(b)
A
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
DISCONNECT
DISCONNECT
DISCONNECT
DISCONNECT
DISCONNECT
DISCONNECT
Disconnect the connector from the tube while pinching
part A with fingers as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Check for contamination in the pipe and around the
connector. Clean if necessary and then disconnect
the connector.
Disconnect the connector with your hands.
A
Do not bend, fold or rotate the nylon tube.
If the pipe and connector are stuck together, push and
B12941
pull the connector until it comes free.
Put the pipe and connector ends in vinyl bags to prevent damage and contamination.
HEATER INLET WATER HOSE
HEATER OUTLET WATER HOSE
RADIATOR HOSE INLET
RADIATOR HOSE OUTLET
OIL COOLER INLET TUBE NO.1
OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE NO.1
40.
DISCONNECT OIL RESERVOIR TO PUMP HOSE NO.1
41.
DISCONNECT STEERING GEAR OUTLET RETURN
TUBE
A80810
A52327
42.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2644
14-152
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
43.
(a)
SEPARATE ENGINE WIRE
Disconnect the engine wire from the ECM and junction
block.
(b) Disconnect the engine wire from the engine room junction
block.
(1) Remove the nut and separate the wire harness.
(2) Using a screwdriver, release the engine room junction block. Disconnect the engine wire by pulling it
upward.
A80811
(c) Remove the 2 nuts and pull out the engine wire.
(d) Remove the body ground.
REMOVE PROPELLER SHAFT ASSY (4WD TYPE) (See page 30-12 )
DISCONNECT EXHAUST PIPE SUB-ASSY FRONT NO.3 (See page 15-5 )
DISCONNECT EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (See page 15-5 )
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE SUPPORT BRACKET NO.1 (See page 15-5 )
DISCONNECT FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
Using a 6 mm socket hexagon wrench, hold the ball stud.
Remove the nut and disconnect the stabilizer link.
DISCONNECT FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
44.
45.
46.
47.
48.
(a)
(b)
49.
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
50.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
Using SST and a hammer, strike the lock nut covering to
remove it.
SST
SST 09930-00010
NOTICE:
Set the drive shaft’s groove so that it faces up. Then
use the SST and hammer.
Remove the covering from the lock nut completely or
the screw of the drive shaft may be damaged.
C65981
Do not sharpen the tip of the SST.
(b) Using a 30 mm socket wrench, remove the lock nut.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB RH NUT
51.
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
52. DISCONNECT SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the speed sensor from the steering knuckle.
NOTICE:
Keep the speed sensor tip and connection free from foreign matter.
53. DISCONNECT SPEED SENSOR FRONT RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2645
14-153
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
54.
(a)
(b)
SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the cotter pin and nut.
Using SST, disconnect the tie rod end from the steering
knuckle.
SST 09628-6201 1
NOTICE:
Do not damage the dust cover of the ball joint.
SST
C65311
55. SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
56.
(a)
(b)
SEPARATE FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY
LOWER NO.1 LH
Remove the bolt and 2 nuts, and separate the front suspension arm from the lower ball joint.
Using a plastic hammer, disconnect the drive shaft from
the axle hub.
C65935
57. SEPARATE FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY LOWER NO.1 RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
58.
(b)
REMOVE DRIVE PLATE & TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SETTING BOLT
Using SST, hold the crankshaft.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
Remove the 2 bolts and flywheel housing under cover.
(c)
Remove the 6 torque converter setting bolts.
(a)
SST
A36243
A52328
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2646
14-154
ENGINE MECHANICAL
59.
(a)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
SEPARATE STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
SUB-ASSY
Loosen the sliding yoke bolt.
A60062
(b)
A60063
Place matchmarks on the steering intermediate shaft and
control valve shaft.
(c) Remove the bolt and disconnect the steering intermediate shaft.
(d) To prevent the steering wheel from rotating, fix the wheel
with the seat belt.
NOTICE:
If the steering wheel is not fixed, the spiral cable will be
damaged.
60.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE
Set the engine lifter.
Remove the 6 bolts, 2 nuts, and frame side rail plate subassembly LH and RH.
(c)
Remove the 6 bolts, 2 nuts, and front suspension member
brace rear LH and RH.
Carefully, remove the engine assembly from the vehicle.
A80812
(d)
A80813
(e)
(f)
Install the engine hanger as shown in the illustration.
Part No.:
No. 2 engine hanger
12282-20020
Bolt
91621-60822
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Using a chain block and an engine sling device, hang the
engine assembly.
A36439
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2647
14-155
ENGINE MECHANICAL
61.
(a)
(b)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER
SUB-ASSY
Disconnect the A/F sensor connector.
Remove the 3 bolts and insulator.
A91368
(c)
3
6
1
(d)
2
5
Uniformly loosen and remove the 6 nuts in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
Remove the manifold and gasket.
4
A91369
62.
INSPECT EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER
SUB-ASSY
(a) Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the surface contacting the cylinder head for warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.50 mm (0.0196 in.)
If the warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the manifold.
A91370
63.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE VANE PUMP ASSY
Remove the power steering oil pressure sensor harness.
Remove the pressure feed tube clamp.
Remove the 2 bolts and vane pump.
A52890
64.
65.
REMOVE STABILIZER BAR FRONT (See page 26-22 )
REMOVE POWER STEERING LINK ASSY (See page 51-28 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2648
14-156
ENGINE MECHANICAL
RH
LH
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
66.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT FRAME ASSY
Remove the 2 nuts and disconnect the engine mounting
insulator RH and LH.
(b)
Remove the nut and disconnect the engine mounting insulator FR.
(c)
Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the engine mounting
insulator RR.
A78403
A80816
A80817
67.
68.
69.
70.
71.
72.
73.
74.
75.
76.
77.
78.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (See page 30-21 )
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (2WD TYPE) (See page 30-21 )
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (4WD TYPE) (See page 30-21 )
REMOVE STARTER ASSY (See page 19-28 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET FR
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (2WD TYPE) (See page 40-20 )
REMOVE TRANSFER STIFFENER PLATE RH (4WD TYPE)
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE W/TRANSFER (4WD TYPE) (See page 40-20 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RR
REMOVE DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSY (See page 14-246 )
INSTALL ENGINE STAND
REMOVE ENGINE HANGER NO.2
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2649
14-157
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(a)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
79.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
Disconnect the 2 VSV connectors.
Remove the wire harness clamp.
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
Disconnect the fuel vapor feed hose No. 1.
Disconnect the fuel vapor feed hose No. 2.
Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses.
Remove the clamp.
Remove the 2 nuts and the emission control valve set.
80.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
Disconnect the throttle motor connector.
Disconnect the water bypass hose No. 3.
Disconnect the water bypass hose No. 2.
Disconnect the union to check valve hose.
(e)
Disconnect the ventilation hose.
(f)
Remove the 3 nuts and disconnect the pressure feed
tube.
(b)
(a)
A79751
(d)
(e)
(e)
(f)
(c)
A82428
(d)
(a)
(c)
(b)
A81623
(e)
A79706
(f)
A81678
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2650
14-158
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(h)
(g)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(g)
(h)
(i)
Remove the 2 bolts and engine hanger No. 1.
Remove the 2 bolts and surge tank stay No. 1.
Remove the 2 bolts and surge tank stay No. 2.
(j)
(k)
Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, remove the 4 bolts.
Remove the 2 nuts, emission control valve bracket and intake air surge tank.
Remove the gasket from the intake air surge tank.
(i)
A81674
(l)
A82427
81.
(a)
INSPECT INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the surface contacting the cylinder head for warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the manifold.
A85565
(b)
(a)
(b)
82.
(a)
(b)
(b)
(b)
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD
Remove the nut and disconnect the ground cable.
Disconnect the 6 fuel injector connectors.
(b)
(b)
A81200
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2651
14-159
ENGINE MECHANICAL
10
4
3
11
7
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(c)
Uniformly loosen and remove the 9 bolts and 2 nuts in the
sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the intake
manifold.
83.
(a)
INSPECT INTAKE MANIFOLD
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the surface contacting the cylinder head and intake
air surge tank for warpage.
Maximum warpage:
2
6
8
-
5
9
1
A81201
Cylinder Head Side
Item
Specified Condition
Intake air surge tank side
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
Cylinder head side
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the manifold.
Air Intake Chamber Side
A85566
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2652
14-160
ENGINE MECHANICAL
84.
(a)
(b)
(e)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(c)
(f)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE WATER OUTLET
Disconnect the radiator hose inlet.
Disconnect the engine coolant temperature sensor connector.
Remove the clamp.
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and 2 washers.
Lock the hose clamp as shown in the illustration and remove the water outlet together with the water bypass
hose No. 1.
Remove the 2 gaskets from the 2 cylinder heads.
A81203
85.
REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSY
86.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER
SUB-ASSY NO.2
Disconnect the A/F sensor connector.
Remove the bolt, nut and insulator No. 3.
(c)
Remove the 2 bolts and insulator No. 2.
A86565
A86566
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2653
14-161
ENGINE MECHANICAL
4
7
6
3
(d)
2
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(e)
Uniformly loosen and remove the 7 nuts in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
Remove the converter and gasket.
(f)
Remove the 2 bolts and manifold stay.
5
1
A86567
A86568
87.
INSPECT EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER
SUB-ASSY NO.2
(a) Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the surface contacting the cylinder head for warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.50 mm (0.0196 in.)
If the warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the manifold.
A90216
88.
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
89.
(a)
REMOVE PUMP BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and pump bracket.
A05189
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2654
14-162
ENGINE MECHANICAL
90.
91.
92.
93.
94.
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
GENERATOR BRACKET NO.1
COMPRESSOR MOUNTING BRACKET NO.1
WATER INLET PIPE (See page 16-31 )
WATER INLET (See page 16-31 )
THERMOSTAT (See page 16-31 )
95. REMOVE ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY
(a) Remove the oil pressure switch.
Oil Pressure Switch
A52637
96.
(a)
97.
REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR
Remove the 2 nuts and 2 sensors.
REPLACE PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY
98.
(a)
Upper
0 to 5
INSTALL KNOCK SENSOR
Install the 2 knock sensors with the 2 nuts, as shown in
the illustration.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Engine
Front
A79750
99.
(a)
(b)
100.
101.
102.
103.
104.
105.
106.
INSTALL ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY
Clean the threads of the oil pressure switch. Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the oil pressure switch.
Adhesive: Part No. 08833-00080 THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Install the oil pressure switch.
Torque: 15 N⋅m (153 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL THERMOSTAT (See page 16-31 )
INSTALL WATER INLET (See page 16-31 )
INSTALL WATER INLET PIPE (See page 16-31 )
INSTALL COMPRESSOR MOUNTING BRACKET NO.1
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL GENERATOR BRACKET NO.1
Torque: 58 N⋅m (591 kgf⋅cm, 43 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL PUMP BRACKET
Torque: 32 N⋅m (326 kgf⋅cm, 24 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Torque: 54 N⋅m (551 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2655
14-163
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
107. INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER
SUB-ASSY NO.2
(a) Install the manifold stay with the 2 bolts, as shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
A86568
1
4
(b)
6
(c)
2
5
Install a new gasket and the converter sub-assy No. 2
with the 7 nuts. Uniformly, tighten the 7 nuts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
Retighten nuts 1 and 2 as shown in the illustration.
3
7
A86567
(d)
Install the insulator No. 2 with the bolt and nut, as shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
(e)
Install the insulator No. 3 with the bolt and nut, as shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the A/F sensor connector.
A86566
(f)
A86565
108. INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSY
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2656
14-164
ENGINE MECHANICAL
109.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL WATER OUTLET
Install 2 new gaskets to the 2 cylinder heads.
Install the water outlet together with the water bypass hose No. 1 and unlock the hose clamp.
Tighten the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and 2 washers.
Torque: 15 N⋅m (153 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
Install the clamp.
Connect the engine coolant temperature sensor connector.
Connect the radiator hose inlet.
(d)
(e)
(f)
110. INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Install the intake manifold with the 9 bolts, 2 nuts and 2
washers. Uniformly tighten the bolts and nuts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 15 N⋅m (153 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Retighten the water outlet mounting bolts and nuts.
Torque: 15 N⋅m (153 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
(c) Install the ground cable with the nut.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
(d) Connect the heater inlet water hose.
2
8
10
6
4
9
1
7
11
3
5
A81201
111. INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK
(a) Install a new gasket to the intake air surge tank.
(b) Install the intake air surge tank and emission control valve
bracket with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
(c) Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, tighten the 4 bolts.
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
A82427
(d)
(e)
(f)
(e)
(f)
(d)
Install the surge tank stay No. 2 with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Install the surge tank stay No. 1 with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Install the engine hanger No. 1 with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
A81674
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2657
14-165
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(g)
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(g)
Install the pressure feed tube with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
(h)
Connect the ventilation hose.
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
Connect
Connect
Connect
Connect
A81678
(h)
A79706
(i)
the
the
the
the
union to the check valve hose.
water bypass hose No. 2.
water bypass hose No. 3.
throttle motor connector.
(l)
(K)
(j)
A81623
(d)
(c)
(c)
(a)
(a)
(a)
(b)
112. INSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
(a) Install the emission control valve set with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
(b) Install the clamp.
(c) Connect the 2 vacuum hoses.
(d) Connect the fuel vapor feed hose No. 2.
(e) Connect the fuel vapor feed hose No. 1.
(e)
A82428
(f)
(g)
Install the wire harness clamp.
Connect the 2 VSV connectors.
(g)
(g)
(f)
A79751
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2658
14-166
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
113. INSTALL ENGINE HANGER NO.2
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
114. REMOVE ENGINE STAND
115. INSTALL DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSY (See page 14-246 )
116. INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RR
117. INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE W/TRANSFER (4WD TYPE) (See page 40-20 )
118. INSTALL TRANSFER STIFFENER PLATE RH (4WD TYPE)
119. INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (2WD TYPE) (See page 40-18 )
120. INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET FR
121. INSTALL STARTER ASSY (See page 19-28 )
122. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (See page 30-21 )
123. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (2WD TYPE) (See page 30-21 )
124. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (4WD TYPE) (See page 30-21 )
125. INSTALL FRONT FRAME ASSY
(a) Install the engine mounting insulator RH and LH with the
2 nuts.
Torque: 95 N⋅m (969 kgf⋅cm, 70 ft⋅lbf)
A78403
(b)
Install the engine mounting insulator FR with the nut.
Torque: 87 N⋅m (887 kgf⋅cm, 64 ft⋅lbf)
(c)
Install the engine mounting insulator RR with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 75 N⋅m (765 kgf⋅cm, 55 ft⋅lbf)
A80816
A80817
126. INSTALL POWER STEERING LINK ASSY (See page 51-28 )
127. INSTALL STABILIZER BAR FRONT (See page 26-22 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2659
14-167
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
128. INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSY
(a) Install the vane pump with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
After adjusting the V-ribbed belt, tighten bolt A.
A
A52337
1
4
129. INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER
SUB-ASSY
(a) Install a new gasket and the exhaust manifold RH. Uniformly tighten the 6 nuts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Retighten nuts 1 and 2 shown in the illustration.
6
5
3
2
A91369
(c)
(d)
Install the insulator with the 3 bolts, as shown in the illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the A/F sensor connector.
A91368
B
B
B
C
B
C
A
A
A80812
130. INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE
(a) Set the engine assembly with transaxle on the engine lifter.
(b) Install the engine assembly to the vehicle.
(c) Install the frame side rail plate RH and LH with the 6 bolts
and 2 nuts.
Torque:
85 N⋅m (867 kgf⋅cm, 63 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
32 N⋅m (326 kgf⋅cm, 24 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B and nut C
(d)
A
A
C
B
B
C
Install the front suspension member brace rear RH and
LH with the 6 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque:
85 N⋅m (867 kgf⋅cm, 63 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
32 N⋅m (326 kgf⋅cm, 24 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B and nut C
B
B
A80813
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2660
14-168
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
131. CONNECT STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
SUB-ASSY
(a) Align the matchmarks on the intermediate shaft and the
control valve shaft, and install the bolt.
Torque: 35 N⋅m (357 kgf⋅cm, 26 ft⋅lbf)
A60063
(b)
Tighten the sliding yoke bolt.
Torque: 35 N⋅m (357 kgf⋅cm, 26 ft⋅lbf)
A60062
SST
A36243
132. INSTALL DRIVE PLATE & TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SETTING BOLT
(a) Using SST, hold the crankshaft.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
(b) Using kerosene or gasoline, clean the bolts thoroughly.
(c) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the bolt end.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(d)
Install the 6 torque converter set bolts.
Torque: 41 N⋅m (418 kgf⋅cm, 30 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
First tighten the green colored bolt and then tighten the 5
bolts.
(e) Install the flywheel housing under cover with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 70 in.⋅lbf)
A52328
133. INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB- ASSY
LOWER NO.1 LH
(a) Install the drive shaft to the steering knuckle.
(b) Install the suspension lower arm with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 127 N⋅m (1,295 kgf⋅cm, 94 ft⋅lbf)
C65935
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2661
14-169
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
134. INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY LOWER NO.1 RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
135. INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY LH
(a) Connect the tie rod end to the steering knuckle and install a new castle nut.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Prevent any lubricant from contacting the thread and the taper portions.
After tightening the castle nut, tighten it to the additional direction within 60 to put into a cotter
pin.
(b) Insert a new cotter pin.
136. INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
137. INSTALL SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH (See page 32-40 )
138. INSTALL SPEED SENSOR FRONT RH (See page 32-40 )
139. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
(a) Using a 30 mm socket wrench, install a new hub nut.
Torque: 294 N⋅m (2,998 kgf⋅cm, 217 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Using a chisel and hammer, tap the front axle hub LH nut.
C65982
140. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB RH NUT
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
141. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
(a) Using a 6 mm socket hexagon wrench, hold the ball stud and install the nut.
Torque: 74 N⋅m (755 kgf⋅cm, 55 ft⋅lbf)
142. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
143. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE SUPPORT BRACKET NO.1 (See page 15-5 )
144. CONNECT EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (See page 15-5 )
145. CONNECT EXHAUST PIPE SUB-ASSY FRONT NO.3 (See page 15-5 )
146. INSTALL PROPELLER SHAFT (4WD TYPE) (See page 30-12 )
147. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE
148. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSY
149. CONNECT STEERING GEAR OUTLET RETURN TUBE
150. CONNECT OIL RESERVOIR TO PUMP HOSE NO.1
151. CONNECT OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE NO.1
152. CONNECT OIL COOLER INLET TUBE NO.1
153. CONNECT RADIATOR HOSE OUTLET
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2662
14-170
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
154. CONNECT RADIATOR HOSE INLET
155. CONNECT HEATER OUTLET WATER HOSE
156. CONNECT HEATER INLET WATER HOSE
157. CONNECT FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSY NO.1
(a) Push in the fuel tube connector to the fuel pipe until connector makes a ”click” sound.
NOTICE:
Check for damage or contamination on the connected
part of the pipe.
After having finished the connection, check if the pipe
and the connector are securely connected by trying
to pull them apart.
B12944
(b) Install the fuel pipe clamp.
158. CONNECT UNION TO CHECK VALVE HOSE
159. INSTALL TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY (See page 40-20 )
160. INSTALL COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
(a) Install the compressor with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install the adjusting bar bracket with the bolt and nut.
Torque:
25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf) for bolt
26 N⋅m (265 kgf⋅cm, 19 ft⋅lbf) for nut
Adjusting Bar Bracket
A52901
161. INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
(a) Install the mounting stay and mounting bracket with the
bolt.
Torque: 64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
A52344
B
A
A
162. INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
(a) Install the control rod and bracket with the 4 bolts.
Torque:
64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
23 N⋅m (235 kgf⋅cm, 17 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
A
A90268
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2663
14-171
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
163. INSTALL GENERATOR BELT ADJUSTING BAR
(a) Install the adjusting bar with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque:
43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf) for nut A
18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf) for bolt C
A
C
B
A52342
164. INSTALL GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
165. INSTALL GENERATOR ASSY (See page 19-40 )
166. INSTALL VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
167. INSTALL V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
168. INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION (See page 14-121 )
169. INSTALL AIR CLEANER CASE
170. INSTALL AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUB-ASSY
171. INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
172. CONNECT VACUUM HOSES
Vacuum Hose Routing Diagram
From Canister
Actuator
Vacuum Surge
Tank
VSV for EVAP
Vacuum Tank
VSV for IAC Valve No. 2
Engine Mounting
Insulator FR
Cap
VSV for Control Engine Mount (ACM)
A91373
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2664
14-172
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
PARTIAL ENGINE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
173. INSTALL BATTERY
174. INSTALL V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY
(a) Fit the 2 retainers and install the V-bank cover.
(b) Using a socket hexagon wrench 5, tighten the 3 nuts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
A81195
175. INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
176. INSTALL COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
177. INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
178. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
179. INSTALL FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
180. INSTALL FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
181. INSTALL FRONT WHEELS
182. ADD TRANSFER OIL (4WD TYPE)
183. INSPECT TRANSFER OIL (4WD TYPE)
184. ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
185. ADD ENGINE OIL
186. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
187. ADD POWER STEERING FLUID
188. BLEED POWER STEERING FLUID (See page 51-3 )
189. INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
190. CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
191. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-20 )
192. CHECK POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKAGE
193. INSPECT FOR FUEL LEAKS
194. CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
195. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See page 26-7 )
196. INSPECT IGNITION TIMING (See page 14-121 )
197. INSPECT ENGINE IDLE SPEED (See page 14-121 )
198. INSPECT CO/HC (See page 14-121 )
199. CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (See page 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2665
14-206
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
TIMING BELT (3MZ-FE)
TIMING BELT (3MZ-FE)
141PL-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
REMOVE VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
14.
(a)
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
Using SST, loosen the pulley bolt.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
SST
A52823
SST
(b)
Using SST and the pulley bolt, remove the pulley.
SST 09950- 50013 (09951- 05010, 09952- 05010,
09953-05020, 09954-05031)
NOTICE:
Before using SST, apply lubricating oil to the threads and
tip of the center bolt 100.
A52839
15.
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2699
14-207
ENGINE MECHANICAL
16.
(a)
Clamp
Clamp
(b)
-
TIMING BELT (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER
Disconnect the engine wire protector clamps from the timing belt No. 3 cover.
Remove the 5 bolts and timing belt cover.
A05050
17.
18.
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2
19.
(a)
REMOVE TIMING BELT
Set the No. 1 cylinder to TDC/compression.
(1) Temporarily install the crankshaft pulley bolt with
the washer to the crankshaft.
(2) Turn the crankshaft clockwise, and align the timing
marks of the crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump
body.
A05051
(3)
(4)
Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing
pulleys and No. 3 timing belt cover are aligned. If
not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360).
Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt.
A05052
(b)
If planning to reuse the timing belt, check that there are
4 installation marks on the timing belt, as shown in the illustration.
(1) If the installation marks have disappeared, put new
installation marks on the timing belt before removing.
A52840
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2700
14-208
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
TIMING BELT (3MZ-FE)
(c)
Approx. 60
Turn
A78327
Set the No. 1 cylinder to approximately 60 BTDC/compression.
(1) Turn the crankshaft counterclockwise by approximately 60.
NOTICE:
With the timing belt removed:
The crankshaft pulley must be at the correct angle to avoid
damage in later steps. If the crankshaft pulley is at the
wrong angle and then the camshaft timing pulley and the
camshaft are removed, the piston head and valve head may
come in contact and be damaged.
(d) Remove the timing belt tensioner.
NOTICE:
Do not reinstall the tensioner with its plunger extended.
(e)
(3)
(5)
(2)
(4)
(1)
Remove the timing belt in this order.
1st
No. 1 idler pulley
2nd
RH camshaft timing pulley
3rd
No. 2 idler pulley
4th
LH camshaft timing pulley
5th
Water pump pulley
6th
Crankshaft timing pulley
(6)
A78702
EM3336
20. INSPECT TIMING BELT
NOTICE:
Do not bend, twist or turn the timing belt inside out.
Do not allow the timing belt to come into contact with
oil, water or steam.
Do not utilize timing belt tension when instaling the
mounting bolt of the camshaft timing pulley.
Check the belt for any defects, as shown in the installation.
Also, check these points below.
(a) If there is premature parting:
Check for proper installation.
Check the timing cover gasket for no damage and
proper installation.
(b) If the belt teeth are cracked or damaged, check to see if
either camshaft is locked.
(c) If there is noticeable wear or cracks on the belt face,
check to see if there are nicks on the side of the idler
pulley lock and water pump.
(d) If there is wear or damage on only one side of the belt,
check the belt guide and the alignment of each pulley.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2701
14-209
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
TIMING BELT (3MZ-FE)
(e)
If there is noticeable wear on the belt teeth:
Check the timing cover for damage.
Check that the gasket has been installed correctly.
Check for foreign object on the pulley teeth.
If there is any doubt about the belt condition, replace the timing
belt.
21. INSTALL TIMING BELT
(a) Remove any oil or water on the pulleys, and keep them
clean.
NOTICE:
If there is a trace of water and/or oil on the timing belt,
repair the leakage and install a new timing belt.
Do not use cleaning agents on the pulleys when
cleaning them.
(b) Inspect the idler pulleys.
(1) Check that the idler pulleys turn smoothly.
(2) Visually check the sealed portion of the idler pulleys
for oil leakage.
If there is any doubt about the idler pulleys condition, replace
the idler pulleys.
(c) Inspect the water pump.
(1) Turn the pulley, and check that the water pump
bearing moves smoothly without any noise.
(2) Visually check the drain hole for coolant leakage.
If there is any doubt about the water pump condition, replace
the water pump.
(d) Temporarily install the crankshaft pulley bolt and washer
to the crankshaft.
(e)
Turn the crankshaft counterclockwise by approximately
60.
NOTICE:
To prevent the piston head and the valve head from colliding, set the crankshaft pulley at approximately 60 BTDC/
compression position.
Approx. 60
Turn
A82349
(f)
Using SST, turn the timing pulleys, and align the timing
marks of the timing pulleys with the No. 3 timing belt cover.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-01000)
SST
A78751
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2702
14-210
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
TIMING BELT (3MZ-FE)
(g)
Turn the crankshaft, and align the timing mark of the
crankshaft timing pulley with the oil pump body.
(h)
(i)
Face the front mark on the timing belt forward.
Align the installation mark on the timing belt with the timing mark of the crankshaft timing pulley.
Align the installation marks on the timing belt with the timing marks of the camshaft timing pulleys.
A05062
(j)
A52840
(k)
(4)
(2)
(5)
(3)
(6)
Install the timing belt in this order.
1st
Crankshaft timing pulley
2nd
Water pump pulley
3rd
LH camshaft timing pulley
4th
No. 2 idler pulley
5th
RH camshaft timing pulley
6th
No. 1 idler pulley
(1)
A78702
A36238
22. INSTALL TIMING BELT TENSIONER ASSY
(a) Set the timing belt tensioner uprightly on the press.
(b) Slowly press in the push rod.
NOTICE:
Do not apply pressure of more than 9.8 kN (1,000 kgf, 2,205
lbf) to the rod.
(c) Align the holes of the push rod and housing, pass a 1.5
mm hexagon wrench through the holes to keep the setting position of the push rod.
(d) Release the push rod.
(e) Temporarily install the tensioner with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 27 N⋅m (275 kgf⋅cm, 20 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Install the tensioner’s bolts uniformly and evenly. Installing the tensioner at an angle may cause it to malfunction.
(f)
Remove the 1.5 mm hexagon wrench from the tensioner.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2703
14-21 1
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
TIMING BELT (3MZ-FE)
(g)
Turn the crankshaft 2 revolutions slowly and align the timing mark of the crankshaft timing pulley with the oil pump
body.
NOTICE:
Always turn the crankshaft clockwise.
Turn
A78326
(h)
Check that the timing marks of the RH and LH timing pulleys are aligned with the timing marks of the No. 3 timing
belt cover, as shown in the illustration.
If the marks do not align, remove the timing belt and reinstall it.
(i)
Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt.
A05052
23.
(a)
INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2
Install the timing belt guide, facing the cup side toward the
engine front.
A36239
24.
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER
Visually check for cracks and breaks on the gasket of the timing belt cover.
25.
(a)
HINT:
If it is judged that water is entering at the visual check, replace the timing belt cover.
(b) Install the timing belt cover.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
26. INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER
(a) Visually check for cracks and breaks on the gasket of the timing belt cover.
HINT:
If there is a trace that water is entering at the visual check, replace the timing belt cover.
(b) Install the timing belt cover.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
(c) Install the engine wire protector cover to the timing belt No. 3 cover.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2704
14-212
ENGINE MECHANICAL
27.
(a)
(b)
-
TIMING BELT (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the pulley,
and slide on the pulley.
Using SST, install the pulley bolt.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
Torque: 220 N⋅m (2,243 kgf⋅cm, 162 ft⋅lbf)
SST
A52823
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
INSTALL GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
INSTALL V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION (See page 14-121 )
INSTALL FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
INSTALL COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY(See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2705
14-213
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
141PM-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
REMOVE V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSY
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
REMOVE VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER (See page 14-206 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2
REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
29.
(a)
RH
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Using SST, remove the bolt and RH timing pulley.
SST 09960- 10010 (09962- 01000, 09963- 01000),
09249-63010
SST
A90211
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2706
14-214
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b)
LH
-
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
Using SST, remove the bolt and LH timing pulley.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-01000)
HINT:
Arrange the camshaft timing pulleys (RH and LH sides) so that
they can be returned to their original locations when reassembled.
SST
A90212
30.
(a)
Clamp
Clamp
(b)
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER
Disconnect the 3 engine wire harness clamps from the
timing belt No. 3 cover.
Remove the 6 bolts and the timing belt cover.
Clamp
A05077
31. REMOVE CAMSHAFT
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be kept level while it is being removed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, damage to the cylinder head or
to the camshaft may result. To avoid this, the following
steps must be carried out.
(a)
Align the camshaft drive and driven gear’s timing marks
(2 dot marks each) by turning the camshaft with a wrench.
Align
A78706
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2707
14-215
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b)
Main Gear
Sub Gear
10
6
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
Secure the exhaust camshaft sub gear to the main gear
with a service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Thread diameter
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 to 20 mm
Service Bolt
A78707
-
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
HINT:
When removing the camshaft, make certain that the torsional
spring force of the sub gear has been eliminated by installation
of the service bolt.
(c)
2
8
1
5
4
9
7
3
Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap bolts in
the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 5
bearing caps and the camshaft.
NOTICE:
Do not pry out the camshaft.
Be careful not to damage the portion of the cylinder
head receiving the shaft thrust.
A78708
5
32.
(a)
1
9
7
2
6
3
10
8
4
A78709
REMOVE NO.2 CAMSHAFT
Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap bolts in
the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 5
bearing caps and the No. 2 camshaft.
NOTICE:
Do not pry out the camshaft.
Be careful not to damage the portion of the cylinder
head receiving the shaft thrust.
(b) Remove the oil seal from the No. 2 camshaft.
33. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
NOTICE:
Do not remove or install the camshaft timing gear (VVT-i)
unless you are replacing the VVT-i or the camshaft.
(a) Clamp the camshaft in a vise on the hexagonal lobe.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the camshaft.
A05739
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2708
14-216
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
(b)
A05740
Using a 46 mm socket wrench, remove the lock nut by
turning it clockwise.
NOTICE:
Remove the lock nut with the lock-pin engaged and
locked at the extreme retarded angle position.
The lock nut has LH threads.
Only use the socket wrench. Other tools will deform
the cam angle rotor.
(c) Remove the timing gear (VVT-i).
NOTICE:
Never remove the 3 bolts on the gear.
If it is difficult to remove the VVT-i, tap it lightly using a plasticfaced hammer and then remove it.
34. REMOVE CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
(a) Clamp the camshaft in a vise on the hexagonal lobe.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the camshaft.
P12596
(b)
Using SST, turn the sub gear counterclockwise, and remove the service bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
(c)
(d)
Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
Remove the wave washer, camshaft sub gear and camshaft gear spring.
SST
P12797
Snap Ring Pliers
A52353
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2709
14-217
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
35. INSTALL CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR
(a) Clamp the camshaft in a vise on the hexagonal lobe.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the camshaft.
P12595
(b)
Wave Washer
Camshaft
Sub Gear
Install the camshaft gear bolt washer and the camshaft
sub gear.
HINT:
Attach the pins on the gears to the gear spring ends.
(c) Install the wave washer.
Camshaft Gear
Bolt Washer
A78732
(d)
Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
Snap Ring Pliers
A52353
(e)
SST
Main Gear
Sub Gear
P12974
Using SST, align the holes of the camshaft main gear and
sub gear by turning the camshaft sub gear counterclockwise, and temporarily install a service bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
(f)
Align the gear teeth of the main gear and sub gear, and
tighten the service bolt.
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not damage the camshaft journals.
HINT:
When installing the camshaft, make certain that the torsional
spring force of the sub gear has been eliminated by installation
of the service bolt.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2710
14-218
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
36.
(a)
Align
A78734
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
Align the alignment pin with the alignment pin groove and
install the VVT-i on the camshaft.
NOTICE:
Install the VVT-i with the lock-pin engaged and locked at
the most retarded angle position.
(b) Apply engine oil to the nut, the mounting surface of the
VVT-i and the screw threads.
NOTICE:
Be sure to apply the oil, otherwise the specified
torque cannot be obtained.
A new nut must be used when replacing the VVT-i
unit.
(c)
Using a 46 mm socket wrench, install and tighten the lock
nut by turning it counterclockwise.
Torque: 150 N⋅m (1,530 kgf⋅cm, 111 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
The lock nut has LH threads.
Only use the socket wrench. Other tools will deform
the cam angle rotor.
A05738
37. INSTALL NO.2 CAMSHAFT
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be held level while it is being installed. If the
camshaft is not level, the portion of the cylinder head receiving the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing
the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this, the following
steps must be carried out.
(a) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of
the camshaft.
(b) Place the No. 2 camshaft at a 90 angle of the timing mark
(2 dot marks) on the cylinder head.
(c) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
90
A05201
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2711
14-219
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
(d) Install the oil seal to the camshaft.
NOTICE:
Do not turn over the oil seal lip.
Insert the oil seal until it stops.
Front
A52366
(e)
Seal Packing
A52367
Remove any old packing material from the contact surface.
(f)
Apply seal packing to the No. 1 bearing cap, as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the No. 1 bearing cap within 5 minutes after applying seal packing.
Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at least 2
hours after installing.
(g) Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(h) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
A05283
6
(i)
10
2
4
Uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 16 N⋅m (163 kgf⋅cm, 12 ft⋅lbf)
9
8
5
1
3
7
A78738
38. INSTALL CAMSHAFT
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be held level while it is being installed. If the
camshaft is not level, the portion of the cylinder head receiving the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing
the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this, the following
steps must be carried out.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2712
14-220
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of
the camshaft.
Align the camshaft drive and driven gear’s timing marks
(2 dot marks each).
Place the camshaft on the cylinder head.
Align
A59546
(d)
(e)
Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
(f)
Uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 16 N⋅m (163 kgf⋅cm, 12 ft⋅lbf)
Remove the service bolt.
A59547
5
9
1
3
10
6
7
(g)
2
4
8
A78740
39.
(a)
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER
Visually check for cracks and breaks in the gasket of the
timing belt cover.
HINT:
If water is entering through cracks or breaks in the gasket, repair according to these guidelines: 1) if the crack length is within
2 to 3 cm (0.79 to 1.18 in.), repair with seal packing; or 2) if the
crack length is over 3 cm (1.18 in.), replace the gasket.
Seal Packing
(b)
When repairing the timing belt cover gasket, follow the
procedure below.
(1) Repair the cracks and breaks by applying the seal
packing to the damaged area.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
When applying the seal packing, apply it as wide and high
as the gasket.
Gasket
A52838
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2713
14-221
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
(c)
If the timing belt cover gasket needs to be replaced, follow
the procedure below.
(1) Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove
the remaining gasket.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the timing belt cover.
(2)
E
F
D
Joining
Line
Joining Portion
Gasket
E
Joining
G Line
Remove the backing paper from a new gasket, and
affix the gasket along the groove of the timing belt
cover, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Affix the gasket in the center of the groove.
At the corners, try to keep the gasket thickness uniform.
Length:
Gasket
D
E
F
G
Specified
Condition
335 mm
(13.19 in.)
180 mm
(7.09 in.)
133 mm
(5.24 in.)
72 mm
(2.83 in.)
(3)
Seal Packing
A78749
Front
If there is a gap on the joint of the gasket, apply seal
packing to close the gap.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
When applying the seal packing, apply it as wide and high
as the gasket.
(d) Install the timing belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
40.
(a)
Front
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Install the camshaft timing pulley with the belt guide properly oriented and tighten the bolt temporarily.
HINT:
Face the belt guide of the RH timing pulley towards the
front of the engine.
Face the belt guide of the LH timing pulley towards the
rear of the engine.
A52833
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2714
14-222
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
(b)
RH
SST
150 mm
A78763
Using SST, tighten the RH pulley bolt.
SST 09960- 10010 (09962- 01000, 09963- 01000),
09249-63010
Torque: 125 N⋅m (1,275 kgf⋅cm, 92 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
The torque specification above is for the SST without extension tool specification. Use the special formula to calculate the SST with extension tool torque specification
(see page 01-5 ).
Extended length of SST (09249-63010):
150 mm (5.91 in.)
(c)
LH
Using SST, tighten the LH pulley bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-01000)
Torque: 125 N⋅m (1,275 kgf⋅cm, 92 ft⋅lbf)
SST
A78762
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
46.
47.
48.
49.
50.
51.
52.
53.
54.
55.
56.
57.
58.
59.
60.
INSTALL TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
Torque: 43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT TENSIONER ASSY (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2 (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE (See page 14-127 )
ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE (See page 14-127 )
INSTALL VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
INSTALL V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION (See page 14-121 )
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSY
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK (See page 14-149 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2715
14-223
ENGINE MECHANICAL
61.
62.
63.
64.
65.
66.
67.
68.
69.
70.
71.
72.
73.
-
CAMSHAFT (RH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
CONNECT VACUUM HOSES (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-20 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2716
14-224
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
141PN-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
REMOVE V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE RADIATOR HOSE INLET
REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSY
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY LH (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
REMOVE VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER (See page 14-206 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2
REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
27.
(a)
RH
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Using SST, remove the bolt and RH timing pulley.
SST 09960- 10010 (09962- 01000, 09963- 01000),
09249-63010
SST
A90211
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2717
14-225
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b)
LH
-
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
Using SST, remove the bolt and LH timing pulley.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-01000)
HINT:
Arrange the camshaft timing pulleys (RH and LH sides) so that
they can be returned to their original locations when reassembled.
SST
A90212
28.
(a)
Clamp
Clamp
(b)
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER
Disconnect the 3 engine wire harness clamps from the
timing belt No. 3 cover.
Remove the 6 bolts and the timing belt cover.
Clamp
A05077
29. REMOVE NO.3 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be kept level while it is being removed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, damage to the cylinder head or
to the camshaft may result. To avoid this, the following
steps must be carried out.
(a)
Align
Align the camshaft drive and driven gear’s timing marks
(1 dot mark each) by turning the camshaft with a wrench.
A78710
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2718
14-226
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b)
Service Bolt
-
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
Secure the exhaust camshaft sub gear to the main gear
with a service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Thread diameter
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 to 20 mm
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
Main Gear
Sub Gear
A78711
(c)
1
5
2
9
6
7
10
8
3
HINT:
When removing the camshaft, make certain that the torsional
spring force of the sub gear has been eliminated by installation
of the service bolt.
4
Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap bolts in
the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 5
bearing caps and the No. 3 camshaft.
NOTICE:
Do not pry out the camshaft.
Be careful not to damage the portion of the cylinder
head receiving the shaft thrust.
A78712
6
30.
(a)
2
10
1
8
5
9
4
7
3
A78713
REMOVE NO.4 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSY
Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap bolts in
the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 5
bearing caps and the No. 4 camshaft.
NOTICE:
Do not pry out the camshaft.
Be careful not to damage the portion of the cylinder
head receiving the shaft thrust.
(b) Remove the oil seal from the No. 4 camshaft.
31. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
NOTICE:
Do not remove or install the timing gear (VVT-i) unless you
are replacing the VVT-i or the camshaft.
(a) Clamp the camshaft in a vise on the hexagonal lobe.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the camshaft.
A05739
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2719
14-227
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
(b)
A05740
Using a 46 mm socket wrench, remove the lock nut by
turning it clockwise.
NOTICE:
Remove it with the lock-pin engaged and locked at
the extreme retarded angle position.
The lock nut has LH threads.
Only use the socket wrench. Other tools will deform
the cam angle rotor.
(c) Remove the timing gear (VVT-i).
NOTICE:
Never remove the 3 bolts on the gear.
If it is difficult to remove the VVT-i, tap it lightly using a plasticfaced hammer and then remove it.
32. REMOVE CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR NO.3
(a) Clamp the camshaft in a vise on the hexagonal lobe.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
P12596
(b)
Using SST, turn the sub gear counterclockwise, and remove the service bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
(c)
(d)
Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
Remove the wave washer, camshaft sub gear and camshaft gear bolt washer.
SST
A78715
Snap Ring Pliers
HINT:
Arrange the camshaft sub gears and gear bolt washers (RH and
LH sides) so that they can be returned to their original location
when reassembled.
A52353
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2720
14-228
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
33. INSTALL CAMSHAFT SUB GEAR NO.3
(a) Clamp the camshaft in a vise on the hexagonal lobe.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
P12595
(b)
Wave Washer
Camshaft
Sub Gear
Install the camshaft gear bolt washer and the camshaft
sub gear.
HINT:
Attach the pins on the gears to the gear bolt washer ends.
(c) Install the wave washer.
Camshaft Gear
Bolt Washer
A78732
(d)
Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
Snap Ring Pliers
A52353
(e)
SST
Main Gear
Sub Gear
A78733
Using SST, align the holes of the camshaft main gear and
sub gear by turning the camshaft sub gear counterclockwise, and temporarily install a service bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00500)
(f)
Align the gear teeth of the main gear and sub gear, and
tighten the service bolt.
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft journals.
HINT:
When installing the camshaft, make certain that the torsional
spring force of the sub gear has been eliminated by installation
of the service bolt.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2721
14-229
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
34.
(a)
Align
A78734
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSY
Align the alignment pin with the alignment pin groove and
install the VVT-i on the camshaft.
NOTICE:
Install the VVT-i with the lock-pin engaged and locked at
the extreme retarded angle position.
(b) Apply engine oil on the nut, the mounting surface of the
VVT-i and the screw threads.
NOTICE:
Be sure to apply the oil, otherwise the specified
torque cannot be obtained.
New nuts must be used when replacing the VVT-i
unit.
(c)
Using a 46 mm socket wrench, install and tighten a lock
nut by turning it counterclockwise.
Torque: 150 N⋅m (1,530 kgf⋅cm, 111 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
The lock nut has LH threads.
Never use any tools other than the socket wrench.
Other tools will deform the cam angle rotor.
A05738
35. INSTALL NO.4 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be kept level while it is being installed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, damage to the cylinder head or
to the camshaft may result. To avoid this, the following
steps must be carried out.
(a)
(b)
90
(c)
Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of
the camshaft.
Place the No. 4 camshaft at a 90 angle of the timing mark
(1 dot mark) on the cylinder head.
Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
A78741
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2722
14-230
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
(d) Install the oil seal to the camshaft.
NOTICE:
Do not turn over the oil seal lip.
Insert the oil seal until it stops.
Front
A78742
(e)
Seal Packing
A78737
Remove any old packing material from the contact surface.
(f)
Apply seal packing to the No. 1 bearing cap, as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the No. 1 bearing cap within 5 minutes after applying seal packing.
Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at least 2
hours after installing.
(g) Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(h) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
A05209
(i)
9
5
1
Uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 16 N⋅m (163 kgf⋅cm, 12 ft⋅lbf)
10
3
6
7
2
4
8
A78743
36. INSTALL NO.3 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be kept level while it is being installed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, damage to the cylinder head or
to the camshaft may result. To avoid this, the following
steps must be carried out.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2723
14-231
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of
the camshaft.
Align the camshaft drive and driven gear’s timing marks
(1 dot mark each).
Place the camshaft on the cylinder head.
Align
A78744
(d)
(e)
Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
(f)
Uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 16 N⋅m (163 kgf⋅cm, 12 ft⋅lbf)
Remove the service bolt.
A05214
10
6
9
2
4
5
(g)
1
8
3
7
A78745
37.
(a)
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER
Visually check for cracks and breaks on the gasket of the
timing belt cover.
HINT:
If water is entering through cracks or breaks in the gasket, repair according to these guidelines: 1) if the crack length is within
2 to 3 cm (0.79 to 1.18 in.), repair with seal packing; or 2) if the
crack length is over 3 cm (1.18 in.), replace the gasket.
Seal Packing
(b)
If the timing belt cover gasket needs to be repaired, follow
the procedure below.
(1) Repair the cracks and breaks by applying the seal
packing to the damaged area.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
When applying the seal packing, apply it as wide and high
as the gasket.
Gasket
A78748
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2724
14-232
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
(c)
If the timing belt cover gasket needs to be replaced, follow
the procedure below.
(1) Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove
the remaining gasket.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the timing belt cover.
(2)
E
F
D
Joining
Line
Joining Portion
Gasket
E
Joining
G Line
Remove the backing paper from a new gasket, and
affix the gasket along the groove of the timing belt
cover, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Affix the gasket in the center of the groove.
At the corners, try to keep the gasket thickness uniform.
Length:
Gasket
D
E
F
G
Specified
Condition
335 mm
(13.19 in.)
180 mm
(7.09 in.)
133 mm
(5.24 in.)
72 mm
(2.83 in.)
(3)
Seal Packing
A78749
Front
If there is a gap on the joint of the gasket, apply seal
packing to close the gap.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
When applying the seal packing, apply it as wide and high
as the gasket.
(d) Install the timing belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
38.
(a)
Front
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Install the camshaft timing pulley with the belt guide properly oriented and tighten the bolt temporarily.
HINT:
Face the belt guide of the RH timing pulley towards the
front of the engine.
Face the belt guide of the LH timing pulley towards the
rear of the engine.
A78750
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2725
14-233
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
(b)
RH
SST
150 mm
A78763
Using SST, tighten the RH pulley bolt.
SST 09960- 10010 (09962- 01000, 09963- 01000),
09249-63010
Torque: 125 N⋅m (1,275 kgf⋅cm, 92 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
The torque specification above is for the SST without extension tool specification. Use the special formula to calculate the SST with extension tool torque specification
(see page 01-5 ).
Extended length of SST (09249-63010):
150 mm (5.91 in.)
(c)
LH
Using SST, tighten the LH pulley bolt.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-01000)
Torque: 125 N⋅m (1,275 kgf⋅cm, 92 ft⋅lbf)
SST
A78762
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
46.
47.
48.
49.
50.
51.
52.
53.
54.
55.
56.
57.
58.
INSTALL TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
Torque: 43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT TENSIONER ASSY (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2 (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE (See page 14-127 )
ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE (See page 14-127 )
INSTALL VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
INSTALL V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION (See page 14-121 )
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY LH (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSY
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL RADIATOR HOSE INLET
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2726
14-234
ENGINE MECHANICAL
59.
60.
61.
62.
63.
64.
65.
66.
67.
68.
-
CAMSHAFT (LH BANK) (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-20 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2727
14-235
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET (3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET (3MZ-FE)
141PO-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
WORK FOR PREVENTING GASOLINE FROM SPILLING OUT (See page 11-35 )
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
REMOVE V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK (See page 14-149 )
DISCONNECT FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSY NO.1 (See page 14-149 )
15.
(a)
(b)
DISCONNECT HEATER INLET WATER HOSE
Lock the hose clamp, as shown in the illustration.
Disconnect the heater inlet water hose.
(b)
(a)
A79759
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD (See page 14-149 )
DISCONNECT RADIATOR HOSE INLET
REMOVE WATER OUTLET (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
REMOVE VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER (See page 14-206 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2728
14-236
ENGINE MECHANICAL
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2
REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page 14-213 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER (See page 14-213 )
SEPARATE VANE PUMP ASSY (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE PROPELLER SHAFT (4WD TYPE) (See page 30-12 )
DISCONNECT EXHAUST PIPE SUB-ASSY FRONT NO.3 (See page 15-5 )
REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSY
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE CAMSHAFT (See page 14-213 )
REMOVE NO.2 CAMSHAFT (See page 14-213 )
44.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSY
Disconnect the camshaft timing oil control valve connector.
Remove the nut and disconnect the engine wire harness
clamp.
A78401
(c)
Front
Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, remove the hexagon
bolt.
A78716
(d)
Uniformly loosen the 8 cylinder head bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 8 cylinder
head bolts and plate washers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the washers into the cylinder
head.
Head warpage or cracking could result from removing bolts in an incorrect order.
Front
2
7
5
3
4
6
8
1
A78717
45.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2729
14-237
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET (3MZ-FE)
46.
(a)
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD SET BOLT
Using a vernier caliper, measure the tension portion diameter of the bolt.
Standard outside diameter:
8.95 to 9.05 mm (0.3524 to 0.3563 in.)
Minimum outside diameter: 8.75 mm (0.3445 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the bolt.
Tension Portion
A52828
47.
(a)
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
Place a new cylinder head gasket on the cylinder block
with the R mark upside down, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Be careful of the installation direction.
To avoid damage to the gasket, place the cylinder
head on the gasket carefully.
Front
A78324
48. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 successive
steps.
(a)
Front
7
2
4
6
5
3
1
8
(b)
(c)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads of the cylinder head bolts.
Install the plate washers to the cylinder head bolts.
Uniformly install and tighten the 8 cylinder head bolts in
the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 54 N⋅m (550 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
A78717
(d)
(e)
90
(f)
Front
Mark the front side of each cylinder head bolt head with
paint, as shown in the illustration.
Retighten the cylinder head bolts by 90 in the same sequence as step (c).
Check that each painted mark is now at a 90 angle to the
front.
Painted mark
A78730
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2730
14-238
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(g)
Front
(h)
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET (3MZ-FE)
Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, install the hexagon
bolt.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the engine wire harness clamp with the nut.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
A78716
49.
50.
51.
52.
53.
54.
55.
56.
57.
58.
59.
60.
61.
62.
63.
64.
65.
66.
67.
68.
69.
70.
71.
72.
73.
74.
75.
76.
77.
78.
79.
80.
81.
82.
83.
INSTALL NO.2 CAMSHAFT (See page 14-213 )
INSTALL CAMSHAFT (See page 14-213 )
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-213 )
INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSY
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
CONNECT EXHAUST PIPE SUB-ASSY FRONT NO.3 (See page 15-5 )
INSTALL PROPELLER SHAFT (4WD TYPE) (See page 30-12 )
INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSY (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER (See page 14-213 )
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page 14-213 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
Torque: 43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT TENSIONER ASSY (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2 (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
INSTALL V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION (See page 14-121 )
INSTALL WATER OUTLET (See page 14-149 )
CONNECT RADIATOR HOSE INLET
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD (See page 14-149 )
CONNECT HEATER INLET WATER HOSE
CONNECT FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSY NO.1 (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
CONNECT VACUUM HOSES (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2731
14-239
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET (3MZ-FE)
84.
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
85. INSTALL COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
86. INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
87. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
88. INSTALL FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
89. INSTALL FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
90. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
91. ADD ENGINE OIL
92. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
93. CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
94. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-20 )
95. INSPECT FOR FUEL LEAKS
96. CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
97. INSPECT IGNITION TIMING (See page 14-121 )
98. INSPECT ENGINE IDLE SPEED (See page 14-121 )
99. INSPECT COMPRESSION (See page 14-121 )
100. INSPECT CO/HC (See page 14-121 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2732
14-240
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET NO.2 (3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET NO.2 (3MZ-FE)
141PP-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
WORK FOR PREVENTING GASOLINE FROM SPILLING OUT (See page 11-35 )
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
REMOVE V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
REMOVE AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUB-ASSY
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CASE
REMOVE EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK (See page 14-149 )
DISCONNECT FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSY NO.1 (See page 14-149 )
DISCONNECT HEATER INLET WATER HOSE (See page 14-235 )
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE RADIATOR HOSE INLET
REMOVE WATER OUTLET (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE RADIATOR HOSE OUTLET
REMOVE WATER INLET PIPE
REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAGE SUB-ASSY
REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAGE GUIDE
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
REMOVE VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER (See page 14-206 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2
REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page 14-224 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER (See page 14-224 )
DISCONNECT EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (See page 15-5 )
REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER SUB-ASSY NO.2 (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSY
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY LH (See page 14-173 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2733
14-241
ENGINE MECHANICAL
46.
47.
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET NO.2 (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE NO.3 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSY (See page 14-224 )
REMOVE NO.4 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSY (See page 14-224 )
48.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD LH
Disconnect the VVT sensor connector.
Disconnect the camshaft timing oil control valve connector.
Remove the bolt and disconnect the ground cable.
Remove the bolt and the wire harness clamp bracket.
A80822
(e)
Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, remove the hexagon
bolt.
Front
A78718
(f)
Uniformly loosen the 8 cylinder head bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration. Remove the 8 cylinder
head bolts and plate washers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the washers into the cylinder
head.
Head warpage or cracking could result from removing bolts in an incorrect order.
Front
4
6
8
1
2
7
5
3
A78719
49.
50.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD GASKET NO.2
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD SET BOLT (See page 14-235 )
51.
(a)
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD GASKET NO.2
Place a new cylinder head gasket on the cylinder block
with the L mark, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Be careful of the installation direction.
To avoid damage to the gasket, place the cylinder
head on the gasket carefully.
Front
A78325
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2734
14-242
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET NO.2 (3MZ-FE)
52. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD LH
NOTICE:
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 successive
steps.
(a)
Front
5
3
1
8
7
2
4
6
(b)
(c)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads of the cylinder head bolts.
Install the plate washer to the cylinder head bolt.
Uniformly install and tighten the 8 cylinder head bolts in
the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 54 N⋅m (550 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
A78719
(d)
(e)
90
(f)
Front
Mark the front side of each cylinder head bolt head with
paint, as shown in the illustration.
Retighten the cylinder head bolts by 90in the same sequence as step (c).
Check that each painted mark is now at a 90 angle to the
front.
Painted mark
A78730
(g)
Front
5
3
1
8
(h)
(i)
7
2
4
Using a socket hexagon wrench 8, install the hexagon
bolt.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
Install the wire harness clamp bracket with the bolt.
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the ground cable with the bolt.
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
6
A78719
53.
54.
55.
56.
57.
58.
59.
60.
61.
62.
63.
64.
65.
INSTALL NO.4 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSY (See page 14-224 )
INSTALL NO.3 CAMSHAFT SUB-ASSY (See page 14-224 )
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY LH (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSY
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER SUB-ASSY NO.2 (See page 14-149 )
CONNECT EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (See page 15-5 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER (See page 14-224 )
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page 14-224 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
INSPECT TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT TENSIONER ASSY (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2 (See page 14-206 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2735
14-243
ENGINE MECHANICAL
66.
67.
68.
69.
70.
71.
72.
73.
74.
75.
76.
77.
78.
79.
80.
81.
82.
83.
84.
85.
86.
87.
88.
89.
90.
91.
92.
93.
94.
95.
96.
97.
98.
99.
100.
101.
102.
103.
104.
105.
106.
107.
-
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET NO.2 (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
INSTALL V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION (See page 14-121 )
INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAGE GUIDE (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAGE SUB-ASSY
INSTALL WATER INLET PIPE
CONNECT RADIATOR HOSE OUTLET
INSTALL WATER OUTLET (See page 14-149 )
CONNECT RADIATOR HOSE INLET
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD (See page 14-149 )
CONNECT HEATER INLET WATER HOSE
CONNECT FUEL PIPE SUB-ASSY NO.1 (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL INTAKE AIR SURGE TANK (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CASE
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY
CONNECT VACUUM HOSES (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL V-BANK COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
ADD ENGINE OIL
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-20 )
INSPECT FOR FUEL LEAKS
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
INSPECT IGNITION TIMING (See page 14-121 )
INSPECT ENGINE IDLE SPEED (See page 14-121 )
INSPECT COMPRESSION (See page 14-121 )
INSPECT CO/HC (See page 14-121 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2736
14-244
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
OIL PUMP SEAL (3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP SEAL (3MZ-FE)
141PQ-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
REMOVE COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
REMOVE VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER (See page 14-206 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2
REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
21.
(a)
(b)
Cut Position
REMOVE OIL PUMP SEAL
Using a knife, cut through the oil seal lip.
Using a screwdriver with its tip wrapped in tape, pry out
the oil seal.
NOTICE:
After the removal, check the crankshaft for damage. If it is
damaged, smooth the surface with 400-grit sandpaper.
A52844
22. INSTALL OIL PUMP SEAL
(a) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
NOTICE:
Keep the lip free of foreign matter.
(b)
Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its surface is flush with the oil pump edge.
SST 09223-00010
NOTICE:
Be careful not to tap the oil seal slantingly.
Wipe off extra grease on the crankshaft.
SST
A13770
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2737
14-245
ENGINE MECHANICAL
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
-
OIL PUMP SEAL (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
INSPECT TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT TENSIONER ASSY (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2 (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER (See page 14-206 )
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
INSTALL V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION (See page 14-121 )
INSTALL COWL PANEL SUB-ASSY
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSY (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2738
14-246
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL (3MZ-FE)
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL (3MZ-FE)
141PR-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (2WD TYPE) (See page 40-20 )
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE W/TRANSFER (4WD TYPE) (See page 40-20 )
3.
(a)
REMOVE DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSY
Using SST, hold the crankshaft.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
(b)
Remove the 8 bolts, the rear spacer, the drive plate and
the front spacer.
SST
A36243
A91073
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
Using a screwdriver with its tip wrapped in tape, pry out
the oil seal.
NOTICE:
After the removal, check if the crankshaft is not damaged.
If it is damaged, smooth the surface with 400-grit sandpaper.
Cut Position
Cut Position
A52843
SST
A36743
5.
INSTALL ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
(a) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
NOTICE:
Keep the lip off foreign materials.
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST 09223-15030, 09950-70010 (09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to tap the oil seal at an angle.
Wipe off extra grease from the crankshaft.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2739
14-247
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL (3MZ-FE)
6.
(a)
SST
A36243
1
5
7
3
4
8
6
2
7.
8.
INSTALL DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSY
Using SST, hold the crankshaft.
SST 09213-54015 (91651-60855), 09330-00021
(b) Clean the bolts and bolt holes.
(c) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the bolts.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(d) Install the front spacer, the drive plate and the rear spacer
on the crankshaft.
(e) Uniformly install and tighten the 8 bolts in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 83 N⋅m (846 kgf⋅cm, 61 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine for at least an hour after installing.
A05416
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE W/TRANSFER (4WD TYPE) (See page 40-20 )
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (2WD TYPE) (See page 40-20 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2740
14-248
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
141PS-01
COMPONENTS
Valve Adjusting Shim
Valve Lifter
Valve Spring Retainer Rock
Valve Spring Retainer
RH Cylinder:
w/ Head Straight Screw
Plug No. 1
Inner Compression Spring
LH Cylinder:
w/ Head Straight Screw
Plug No. 2
Valve Stem Oil Seal
Valve Spring Seat
Exhaust Valve Guide Bush
Gasket
Semicircular Plug
44 (449, 32)
Gasket
Cylinder Head Sub-assy
Intake Valve
Exhaust Valve
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A78310
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2741
14-249
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
141PT-01
OVERHAUL
1.
REMOVE W/HEAD STRAIGHT SCREW PLUG NO.1 (RH CYLINDER)
(a) Using a straight hexagon wrench 14, remove the 2 screw plugs.
2.
REMOVE W/HEAD STRAIGHT SCREW PLUG NO.2 (LH CYLINDER)
(a) Using a straight hexagon wrench 14, remove the 2 screw plugs.
3.
REMOVE VALVE LIFTER
HINT:
Store the lifters in the correct order so that they can be returned to their original locations when reassembled.
4.
(a)
REMOVE INTAKE VALVE
Using SST, compress the valve spring and remove the 2
retainer rocks, retainer, spring, spring seat and valve.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010)
HINT:
Store the valves, valve springs, spring seat, retainer rock and
spring retainers in the correct order so that they can be returned
to their original locations when reassembled.
SST
A05224
5.
(a)
REMOVE EXHAUST VALVE
Using SST, compress the valve spring and remove the 2
retainer rocks, retainer, spring, spring seat and valve.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010)
HINT:
Store the valves, valve springs, spring seat, retainer rock and
spring retainers in the correct order so that they can be returned
to their original locations when reassembled.
SST
A51796
6.
(a)
7.
8.
REMOVE VALVE STEM OIL O SEAL OR RING
Using needle-nose pliers, remove the oil seal.
REMOVE VALVE SPRING SEAT
REMOVE SEMICIRCULAR PLUG
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2742
14-250
ENGINE MECHANICAL
9.
(a)
Cylinder Block Surface
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD FOR FLATNESS
Using a precision straight edge and a feeler gauge, measure the surface contacting the cylinder block and the
manifolds for warpage.
Maximum warpage:
Item
Specified Condition
Cylinder block surface
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Intake manifold surface
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Exhaust manifold surface
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the cylinder head.
Intake Manifold Surface
Exhaust Manifold Surface
A78773
10.
(a)
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD FOR CRACKS
Using a dye penetrant, check the combustion chamber,
intake ports, exhaust ports and cylinder block surface for
cracks.
If cracked, replace the cylinder head.
A05227
11.
(a)
Overall Length
INSPECT INTAKE VALVE
Check the valve overall length.
Standard overall length: 95.45 mm (3.7579 in.)
Minimum overall length: 94.95 mm (3.7382 in.)
If the overall length is less than the minimum, replace the valve.
EM2534
(b)
Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the valve
stem.
Valve stem diameter:
5.470 to 5.485 mm (0.2154 to 0.2159 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the intake
valve.
Z00052
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2743
14-251
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(c)
Check the valve head margin thickness.
Standard margin thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Minimum margin thickness: 0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
If the margin thickness is less than the minimum, replace the
valve.
Margin
Thickness
EM0181
12.
(a)
Overall Length
INSPECT EXHAUST VALVE
Check the valve overall length.
Standard overall length: 95.40 mm (3.7559 in.)
Minimum overall length: 94.90 mm (3.7362 in.)
If the overall length is less than the minimum, replace the valve.
EM2534
(b)
Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the valve
stem.
Valve stem diameter:
5.465 to 5.480 mm (0.2152 to 0.2157 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the exhaust
valve.
Z00052
(c)
Check the valve head margin thickness.
Standard margin thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Minimum margin thickness: 0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
If the margin thickness is less than the minimum, replace the
valve.
Margin
Thickness
EM0181
13.
(a)
INSPECT INNER COMPRESSION SPRING
Using a vernier caliper, measure the free length of the
valve spring.
Free length: 45.50 mm (1.7913 in.)
If the free length is not as specified, replace the valve spring.
EM0801
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2744
14-252
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(b)
Using steel squares, measure the deviation of the valve
spring.
Maximum deviation: 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
If the deviation is greater than the maximum, replace the valve
spring.
Deviation
EM0988
(c)
Using a spring tester, measure the tension of the valve
spring at the specified installed length.
Installed tension:
186 to 206 N (19.0 to 21.0 kgf, 41.9 to 46.3 lbf)
at 33.8 mm (1.331 in.)
If the installed tension is not as specified, replace the valve
spring.
EM0281
14.
(a)
(b)
P12754
INSPECT VALVE GUIDE BUSH OIL CLEARANCE
Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of the
guide bush.
Bush inside diameter:
5.510 to 5.530 mm (0.2169 to 0.2177 in.)
Subtract the valve stem diameter measurement from the
guide bush inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
0.025 to 0.060 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Exhaust
0.030 to 0.065 mm (0.0012 to 0.0026 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
0.080 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust
0.100 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the valve
and guide bush.
15.
(a)
REMOVE VALVE GUIDE BUSH
Heat the cylinder head to approximately 80 to 100C (176
to 212F).
A05234
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2745
14-253
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b)
SST
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Using SST and a hammer, tap out the guide bush.
SST 09201- 10000, 09201- 01055, 09950- 70010
(09951-07100)
P12803
16.
(a)
INSTALL VALVE GUIDE BUSH
Using a caliper gauge, measure the bush bore diameter
of the cylinder head.
Diameter: 10.295 to 10.313 mm (0.4053 to 0.4060 in.)
If the bush bore diameter of the cylinder head is greater than
10.313 mm (0.4060 in.), machine the bush bore to the dimension of 10.345 to 10.363 mm (0.4073 to 0.4080 in.).
Bush diameter:
P12956
34.5 mm
(1.358 in.)
10.333 to 10.344 mm (0.4068 to 0.4072 in.)
O/S
10.383 to 10.394 mm (0.4088 to 0.4092 in.)
HINT:
Use different bushes on the intake and exhaust.
Bush length:
Exhaust
Intake
STD
40.5 mm
(1.594 in.)
Intake
34.5 mm (1.358 in.)
Exhaust
40.5 mm (1.594 in.)
A52198
(b)
SST
(c)
A78778
Heat the cylinder head to approximately 80 to 100C (176
to 212F)
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new guide bush to the
specified protrusion height.
SST 09201- 10000, 09201- 01055, 09950- 70010
(09951-07100)
Protrusion height:
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
11.1 to 11.5 mm (0.437 to 0.453 in.)
Exhaust
8.9 to 9.3 mm (0.350 to 0.336 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2746
14-254
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(d)
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Using a sharp 5.5 mm reamer, ream the guide bush to obtain the standard specified clearance between the guide
bush and the valve stem.
Standard oil clearance:
Item
Specified Condition
Intake
0.025 to 0.060 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Exhaust
0.030 to 0.065 mm (0.0012 to 0.0026 in.)
Z09124
17.
(a)
INSPECT VALVE SEATS
Apply a light coat of prussian blue (or white lead) to the
valve face.
(b) Lightly press the valve against the seat.
NOTICE:
Do not rotate the valve.
(c)
Width
A78779
45
30
Check the valve face and valve seat according to the following procedure.
(1) If blue appears 360 around the valve face, the
valve face is concentric. If not, replace the valve.
(2) If blue appears 360 around the valve seat, the
guide and valve face are concentric. If not, resurface the valve seat.
(3) Check that the valve seat contact is in the middle of
the valve face with the width between 1.0 to 1.4 mm
(0.039 to 0.055 in.).
18. REPAIR VALVE SEATS
NOTICE:
Releasing the seat-cutter pressure gradually helps to
make smoother valve seat faces.
(a) If the seating is too high on the valve face, use 30 and
45 cutters to correct the seat.
1.0-1.4mm
1.0 to
1.4mm A51797
(b)
(c)
60
45
1.0 to 1.4 mm
(d)
If the seating is too low on the valve face, use 60 and 45
cutters to correct the seat.
Handrub the valve and valve seat with an abrasive compound.
Recheck the valve seating position.
A78781
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2747
14-255
ENGINE MECHANICAL
19.
(a)
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT VALVE LIFTER
Using a micrometer, measure the lifter diameter.
Lifter diameter:
30.966 to 30.976 mm (1.2191 to 1.2195 in.)
EM6368
20.
(a)
P12685
INSPECT VALVE LIFTER OIL CLEARANCE
Using a caliper gauge, measure the lifter bore diameter
of the cylinder head.
Lifter bore diameter:
31.009 to 31.025 mm (1.2208 to 1.2215 in.)
(b) Subtract the lifter diameter measurement from the lifter
bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.033 to 0.059 mm (0.0013 to 0.0023 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.070 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the lifter. If necessary, replace the cylinder head.
21. INSPECT CAMSHAFT GEAR BACKLASH
(a) Install the camshaft timing gear assembly.
(b) Install the camshafts to the cylinder head.
NOTICE:
Install without valves and sub gear.
Install with its timing mark matched.
(c)
A33264
Set the dial indicator to the teeth of the intake camshaft
at a right angle (90).
(d) Measure the backlash of the camshaft timing gear at least
4 positions.
Standard backlash:
0.020 to 0.200 mm (0.0008 to 0.0079 in.)
Maximum backlash: 0.300 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the backlash is greater than the maximum, replace the camshafts.
22.
(a)
(b)
A05238
INSPECT CAMSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
Install the camshafts.
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while
moving the camshaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.040 to 0.090 mm (0.0016 to 0.035 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance: 0.120 mm (0.0047 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
camshaft. If necessary, replace the bearing caps and cylinder
head together.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2748
14-256
ENGINE MECHANICAL
23.
(a)
(b)
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT CAMSHAFT OIL CLEARANCE
Clean the bearing caps and camshaft journals.
Place the camshafts on the cylinder head.
(c)
Lay a strip of plastigage across each of the camshaft journal.
(d) Install the bearing caps.
Torque: 16 N⋅m (163 kgf⋅cm, 12 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the camshaft.
(e) Remove the bearing caps.
A05239
(f)
A05240
RH Cylinder
10 mm (0.39 in.)
Measure the plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
Intake #4, #5 journals
0.025 to 0.057 mm (0.0010 to 0.0022 in.)
Other journals
0.025 to 0.062 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.100 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
camshaft. If necessary, replace the bearing caps and cylinder
head together.
NOTICE:
Completely remove the plastigage.
24.
(a)
INSTALL RING W/HEAD PIN (RH CYLINDER)
Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap in a new ring pin to the
specified protrusion height.
Protrusion height: 3 mm (0.12 in.)
25.
(a)
INSTALL RING PIN (LH CYLINDER)
Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap in a new ring pin to the
specified protrusion height.
Protrusion height: 3 mm (0.12 in.)
8 mm (0.31 in.)
A78782
LH Cylinder
10 mm (0.39 in.)
8 mm (0.31 in.)
A78783
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2749
14-257
ENGINE MECHANICAL
26.
(a)
Protrusion Height
Mark
P05423
A51817
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL SPARK PLUG TUBE
Using paint, mark the standard position from the edge.
Standard protrusion height:
42.4 to 43.4 mm (1.669 to 1.709 in.)
HINT:
Use either end of the spark plug tube.
(b) Apply adhesive to the spark plug tube where it will be
pressed into the cylinder head.
Adhesive: Part No. 08833-00070 THREE BOND 1324
or equivalent
NOTICE:
Install the spark plug tube within 3 minutes after applying adhesive.
Do not deform the spark plug tube.
Do not expose the seal to coolant for at least 1 hour
after installing.
(c)
Press
Wooden
Block
-
Protrusion
Height
Using a press and wooden block, install the spark plug
tube to the required protrusion height.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drip the adhesive.
A78785
27.
(a)
INSTALL PCV PIPE (RH CYLINDER)
Using a wooden block and hammer, tap in 2 new PCV
pipes until its top edge is flush with the cylinder head
edge.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head edge.
Wooden
Block
Flush
P12869
A51801
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2750
14-258
ENGINE MECHANICAL
28.
(a)
RH Cylinder
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL STUD BOLT
Install the stud bolts on the intake side.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
49 mm
(1.93 in.)
M8
LH Cylinder
49 mm
(1.93 in.)
M8
A78787
A78788
29.
(a)
A87849
INSTALL STUD BOLT
Install the stud bolts on the exhaust side.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Intake
Exhaust
Light Brown
Gray
A78789
SST
30. INSTALL VALVE STEM OIL O SEAL OR RING
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the valve stem.
NOTICE:
Pay close attention when installing the intake and exhaust
oil seals. For example, installing the intake oil seal into the
exhaust or installing the exhaust oil seal to the intake can
cause installation problems later.
HINT:
The intake valve oil seal is light brown and the exhaust valve oil
seal is gray.
(b) Using SST, push in a new oil seal.
SST 09201-41020
NOTICE:
Failure to use SST will cause the seal to be damaged or improperly seated.
A78790
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2751
14-259
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
31.
(a)
SST
A78770
INSTALL INTAKE VALVE
Install the valve, spring seat, valve spring and spring retainer.
NOTICE:
Install the same part in the same combination to the original locations.
(b) Using SST, compress the valve spring and place the 2
keepers around the valve stem.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010)
(c)
Using a plastic-faced hammer and a discarded valve with
its tip wrapped in tape, lightly tap the installed valve to ensure that it is securely fit.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the installed valve stem tip.
A05246
32.
(a)
SST
A78772
INSTALL EXHAUST VALVE
Install the valve, spring seat, valve spring and spring retainer.
NOTICE:
Install the same parts in the same combination to the original locations.
(b) Using SST, compress the valve spring and place the 2
keepers around the valve stem.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010)
(c)
Using a plastic-faced hammer and a discarded valve with
its tip wrapped in tape, lightly tap the installed valve to ensure that it is securely fit.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the installed valve stem tip.
A05246
33. INSTALL VALVE LIFTER
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the valve lifter.
NOTICE:
Install the same part in the same combination to the original locations.
(b) Install the valve lifter.
(c) Check that the valve lifter rotates smoothly by hand.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2752
14-260
ENGINE MECHANICAL
34.
(a)
(b)
Seal Packing
-
CYLINDER HEAD ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL SEMICIRCULAR PLUG
Remove any old seal packing (FIPG) material.
Apply seal packing to the semicircular plug grooves.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
A51804
(c) Install the 2 semicircular plugs to the cylinder heads.
NOTICE:
Install the plugs so that they are flush with the top of
the cylinder head.
Install the semicircular plugs within 3 minutes after
applying seal packing.
Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at least 2
hours after installing.
: Semicircular Plug
RH Cylinder
Front
LH Cylinder
A78792
35.
(a)
36.
(a)
INSTALL W/HEAD STRAIGHT SCREW PLUG NO.1 (RH CYLINDER)
Using a straight hexagon wrench 14, install 2 new gaskets and the 2 screw plugs.
Torque: 44 N⋅m (449 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL W/HEAD STRAIGHT SCREW PLUG NO.2 (LH CYLINDER)
Using a straight hexagon wrench 14, install 2 new gaskets and the 2 screw plugs.
Torque: 44 N⋅m (449 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2753
14-261
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
141PU-01
COMPONENTS
3
Piston Ring (No. 1 Compression Ring)
Piston Ring (No. 2 Compression Ring)
Piston Ring (Expander)
Piston Ring (Side Rail)
Piston Pin Hole
Snap Ring
Piston Pin
Piston
Piston Pin Hole Snap Ring
Connecting Rod
Small End Bush
Connecting Rod Sub-assy
Connecting Rod Bearing
Connecting Rod Cap
See page (14-263 )
1st: 25 (255, 18)
2nd: Turn 90
Gasket
50 (510, 37)
Cylinder Block w/ Head
Straight Screw No. 3 Plug
39 (398, 29)
Cylinder Block Water
Drain Cock Sub-assy
30 (306, 22)
Cylinder Block w/ Head
Straight Screw No. 1 Plug
Gasket
Cylinder Block Sub-assy
Gasket
30 (306, 22)
39 (398, 29)
Cylinder Block Water
Drain Cock Sub-assy
Cylinder Block w/ Head
Straight Screw No. 2 Plug
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Precoated part
Water Seal Plate
18 (184, 13)
A78311
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2754
14-262
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Cylinder Block Sub-assy
Seal Washer
×4
27 (275, 20)
Crankshaft Bearing
Upper Crankshaft
Thrust Washer
Crankshaft
Crankshaft Bearing
Lower Crankshaft Thrust Washer
Crankshaft Bearing Cap
×4
See page (14-263 )
1st: 22 (224, 16)
2nd: Turn 90
× 16
27 (275, 20)
×4
Seal Washer
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A78312
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2755
14-263
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
141PV-02
OVERHAUL
1.
2.
3.
(a)
4.
(a)
5.
(a)
REMOVE CYLINDER BLOCK WATER DRAIN COCK SUB-ASSY
REMOVE WATER SEAL PLATE
REMOVE CYLINDER BLOCK W/HEAD STRAIGHT SCREW NO.1 PLUG
Using a socket hexagon wrench 10, remove the screw plug.
REMOVE CYLINDER BLOCK W/HEAD STRAIGHT SCREW NO.2 PLUG
Using a socket hexagon wrench 10, remove the screw plug.
REMOVE CYLINDER BLOCK W/HEAD STRAIGHT SCREW NO.3 PLUG
Using a socket hexagon wrench 10, remove the screw plug.
6.
(a)
P12695
Plastigage
INSPECT CONNECTING ROD THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while
moving the connecting rod back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.150 to 0.300 mm (0.0059 to 0.0118 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance: 0.350 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
connecting rod assembly(s). If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
Connecting rod thickness:
20.80 to 20.85 mm (0.8189 to 0.8209 in.)
7.
INSPECT CONNECTING ROD OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Check that the matchmarks on the connecting rod and
cap are aligned to ensure correct reassembly.
(b) Remove the 2 connecting rod cap bolts.
(c) Clean the crank pin, the bearing and the connecting rod.
(d) Check the crank pin and bearing for pitting and scratches.
(e)
Lay a strip of plastigage across the crank pin.
(f)
Check that the protrusion of the connecting rod cap is facing the correct direction.
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the connecting rod cap bolts.
A78793
Front
(g)
Protrusion
A78794
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2756
14-264
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(h)
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Tighten the bolts in several steps by the specified torque.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
P12697
(i)
Mark the front side of each connecting cap bolt with paint.
(j)
Retighten the cap bolts by 90 as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
(k) Remove the 2 bolts, the connecting rod cap and the lower
bearing.
Painted Mark
90
90
Front
A78795
(l)
Measure the plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.038 to 0.066 mm (0.0015 to 0.0026 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.080 mm (0.0031 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
bearings. If necessary, grind or replace the crankshaft.
(m) Completely remove the plastigage.
P12698
HINT:
If replacing the bearing, replace it with one that has the same
number as the connecting rod. There are 4 sizes of standard
bearings: 1, 2, 3 and 4.
Standard bearing center wall thickness:
Number Mark
A79803
Mark
Center Wall Thickness mm (in.)
1
1.484 to 1.486 (0.05843 to 0.05850)
2
1.487 to 1.489 (0.05854 to 0.05862)
3
1.490 to 1.492 (0.05866 to 0.05874)
4
1.493 to 1.495 (0.05878 to 0.05886)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2757
14-265
ENGINE MECHANICAL
8.
(a)
(b)
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE PISTON SUB-ASSY W/CONNECTING ROD
Using a ridge reamer, remove all the carbon from the top
of the cylinder.
Push out the piston and the connecting rod assembly
from the top of the cylinder block.
HINT:
A05258
9.
Keep the bearings, the connecting rod and the cap together.
Arrange the piston and the connecting rod assemblies in
the correct order so they can be returned to their original
locations when reassembled.
REMOVE CONNECTING ROD BEARING
10.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE PISTON RING SET
Using a piston ring expander, remove the 2 compression
rings.
Remove the 2 side rails and oil ring by hand.
11.
(a)
REMOVE PISTON PIN HOLE SNAP RING
Using a small screwdriver, pry out the 2 snap rings.
12.
(a)
REMOVE W/PIN PISTON SUB-ASSY
Gradually heat the piston to approximately 80C (176F).
A78315
P12403
80C
A78797
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2758
14-266
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(b)
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Using a plastic-faced hammer and a brass bar, lightly tap
out the piston pin and remove the connecting rod.
HINT:
The piston and pin are a matched set.
Store the pistons, the pins, the rings, the connecting rods
and the bearings in the correct order so that they can be
returned to their original locations when reassembled.
P12415
13.
(a)
P12799
5
8
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while
prying the crankshaft back and forth with a screwdriver.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.04 to 0.24 mm (0.0016 to 0.0094 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance: 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
thrust washers as a set. Check the crankshaft for wear, repair
or replace if necessary.
Thrust washer thickness:
1.93 to 1.98 mm (0.0760 to 0.0780 in.)
14.
(a)
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT OIL CLEARANCE
Uniformly loosen and remove the 8 main bearing cap
bolts and seal washers in the sequence shown in the illustration.
(b)
Uniformly loosen and remove the 16 main bearing cap
bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
7
6
2
3
4
1
6 14
2
10
8 16
A87850
4
12
11
3
15
13
7
9
5
1
A87851
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2759
14-267
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(c)
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Remove the 4 main bearing caps and 4 lower bearings.
Also remove the 2 lower thrust washers, located under
the No. 2 main bearing cap.
A87852
Cylinder
Block
M a i n
Bearing
Cap
Joint Surface
A87853
NOTICE:
Using a screwdriver, push up on the cap little by little, alternating from the right and left side until the cap is free. Take
care not to damage the contact surfaces of the cap and cylinder block.
HINT:
Keep the lower bearing and main bearing cap together.
Arrange the main bearing caps and lower thrust washers
in the correct order.
(d) Lift out the crankshaft.
HINT:
Keep the upper bearings together with the cylinder block.
(e) Clean each main journal and bearing.
(f)
Check each main journal and bearing for pitting and
scratches.
If the journal or bearing is damaged, replace the bearings. If
necessary, replace the crankshaft.
A87854
Plastigage
(g)
(h)
Place the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
Lay a strip of plastigage across each journal.
(i)
Install the 4 main bearing caps.
A87856
A87855
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2760
14-268
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
(j)
Remove the main bearing caps (see steps (a) to (c)).
(k)
Measure the plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
No. 1 and No. 4 journals
0.014 to 0.034 mm (0.0006 to 0.0013 in.)
No. 2 and No. 3 journals
0.026 to 0.046 mm (0.0010 to 0.0018 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
A87857
No.1
No.2
No.3
No.4
Number Mark
No.2 No.3
No.4
No.1
Number
Mark
No. 1 and No. 4 journals
0.050 mm (0.0020 in.)
No. 2 and No. 3 journals
0.060 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
bearings. If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
HINT:
If using a bearing, replace it with one that has the same number.
If the number of the bearing cannot be determined, select the
correct bearing by adding together the numbers imprinted on
the cylinder block and crankshaft, then refer to the table on the
next page for the appropriate bearing number. The No. 1 and
No. 4 journal bearings have 5 standard bearing sizes, marked
3, 4, 5, 6 and 7 accordingly. The No. 2 and No. 3 journal bearings have 5 standard bearing sizes, marked 1, 2, 3, 4 and 5 accordingly.
Number Mark
A87858
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2761
14-269
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
No. 1 and No. 4 journal bearings
Cylinder
block
+
Crankshaft
=
0 to 5
6 to 11
12 to 17
18 to 23
24 to 28
Replacement
Bearing
3
4
5
6
7
HINT:
EXAMPLE
Cylinder block imprinted number mark is 06
Crankshaft imprinted number mark is 08
6 + 8 = 14
Select the bearing marked ”5”
No. 1 and No. 4 journal standard bearings selection chart
Cylinder block number mark
Crankshaft
number mark
00
01
02
03
04
05
06 07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
00
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
01
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
02
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
03
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
04
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
05
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
06
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
07
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
08
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
7
09
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
7
7
10
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
7
7
7
11
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
7
7
7
7
12
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
7
7
7
7
7
EXAMPLE:
Cylinder block ”06”, Crankshaft ”08” = Use bearing ”5”
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2762
14-270
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
No. 2 and No. 3 journal bearings
Cylinder
block
+
Crankshaft
=
0 to 5
6 to 11
12 to 17
18 to 23
24 to 28
Replacement
Bearing
3
4
5
6
7
HINT:
EXAMPLE
Cylinder block imprinted number mark is 06
Crankshaft imprinted number mark is 08
6 + 8 = 14
Select the bearing marked ”3”
No.2 and No.3 journal standard bearings selection chart
Cylinder block number mark
Crankshaft
number mark
00
01
02
03
04
05
06 07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
00
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
01
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
02
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
03
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
04
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
05
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
06
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
07
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
08
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
09
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
10
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
11
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
12
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
EXAMPLE:
Cylinder block ”06”, Crankshaft ”08” = Use bearing ”3”
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2763
14-271
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Reference
Item
Mark
Specified Condition
Cylinder block main journal bore diameter (A)
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
66.000 mm (2.5984 in.)
66.001 mm (2.5985 in.)
66.002 mm (2.5985 in.)
66.003 mm (2.5985 in.)
66.004 mm (2.5986 in.)
66.005 mm(2.5986 in.)
66.006 mm (2.5987 in.)
66.007 mm (2.5987 in.)
66.008 mm (2.5987 in.)
66.009 mm (2.5988 in.)
66.010 mm (2.5988 in.)
66.011 mm (2.5989 in.)
66.012 mm (2.5989 in.)
66.013 mm (2.5989 in.)
66.014 mm (2.5990 in.)
66.015 mm (2.5990 in.)
66.016 mm (2.5990 in.)
Crankshaft main journal diameter (B)
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
61.000 mm (2.4016 in.)
60.999 mm (2.4015 in.)
60.998 mm (2.4015 in.)
60.997 mm (2.4015 in.)
60.996 mm (2.4014 in.)
60.995 mm (2.4014 in.)
60.994 mm (2.4013 in.)
60.993 mm (2.4012 in.)
60.992 mm (2.4012 in.)
60.991 mm (2.4012 in.)
60.990 mm (2.4012 in.)
60.989 mm (2.4011 in.)
60.988 mm (2.4011 in.)
Standard bearing center wall thickness
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
2.486 to 2.489 mm (0.0979 to 0.0980 in.)
2.489 to 2.492 mm (0.0980 to 0.0981 in.)
2.492 to 2.495 mm (0.0981 to 0.0982 in.)
2.495 to 2.498 mm (0.0982 to 0.0983 in.)
2.498 to 2.501 mm (0.0983 to 0.0985 in.)
2.501 to 2.504 mm (0.0985 to 0.0986 in.)
2.504 to 2.507 mm (0.0986 to 0.0987 in.)
(l)
Completely remove the plastigage.
15. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT
(a) Lift the crankshaft.
(b) Remove the 4 upper main bearings and 2 upper thrust washers from the cylinder block.
HINT:
Arrange the main bearing caps, bearings and thrust washers in the correct order.
16. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT THRUST WASHER SET
17. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT BEARING
18. CLEAN CYLINDER BLOCK
NOTICE:
If the cylinder is washed at high temperatures, the cylinder liner sticks out beyond the cylinder block.
Always wash the cylinder block at a temperature of 45C (113F) or less.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2764
14-272
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
19.
(a)
INSPECT CYLINDER BLOCK FOR FLATNESS
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the surface contacting the cylinder head gasket for
warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the cylinder block.
Z09222
20.
(a)
INSPECT CYLINDER BORE
Using a cylinder gauge, measure the cylinder bore diameter at positions A and B in the thrust and axial directions.
Specified diameter:
92.000 to 92.132 mm (3.6220 to 3.6272 in.)
If the measured diameters is greater than the maximum, replace the cylinder block.
Thrust Direction
Front
Axial Direction
A
10 mm
B
A88898
21.
(a)
13.0 mm
INSPECT W/PIN PISTON SUB-ASSY
Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the piston.
When you measure the diameter, attach the micrometer
to a location where 13.0 mm (0.512 in.) above from the
piston bottom and meets at the right angles to the piston
pin hole.
Piston diameter:
91.953 to 91.967 mm (3.6202 to 3.6207 in.)
A78316
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2765
14-273
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
22.
(a)
INSPECT PISTON OIL CLEARANCE
Subtract the piston diameter measurement from the cylinder bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance: 0.033 to 0.059 mm (0.0013 to 0.0023 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.130 mm (0.0051 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace all the 6 pistons. If necessary, replace the cylinder
block.
23.
(a)
INSPECT CONNECTING ROD SUB-ASSY
Using a rod aligner and feeler gauge, check the connecting rod alignment.
(1) Check for misalignment.
Maximum misalignment:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If misalignment is greater than the maximum, replace the connecting rod assembly.
Z00064
(2) Check for twist.
Maximum twist:
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If the twist is greater than the maximum, replace the connecting
rod assembly.
Z00065
24.
(a)
INSPECT PISTON PIN OIL CLEARANCE
Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of the
connecting rod bush.
Bush inside diameter:
22.005 to 22.014 mm (0.8663 to 0.8667 in.)
(b)
Using a micrometer, measure the piston pin diameter.
Piston pin diameter:
21.997 to 22.006 mm (0.8660 to 0.8664 in.)
EM6525
EM0227
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2766
14-274
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(c)
Subtract the piston pin diameter measurement from the
bush inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.005 to 0.011 mm (0.0002 to 0.0004 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.050 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
bush. If necessary, replace the piston and the piston pin together.
25.
(a)
REMOVE CONNECTING ROD SMALL END BUSH
Using SST and a press, press out the bush.
SST 09222-30010
26.
(a)
INSTALL CONNECTING ROD SMALL END BUSH
Align the oil holes of a new bush and the connecting rod.
(b)
Using SST and a press, press in the bush.
SST 09222-30010
(c)
Using a pin hole grinder, hone the bushing to obtain the
standard clearance between the bush and piston pin.
Standard oil clearance:
0.005 to 0.011 mm (0.0002 to 0.0004 in.)
SST
A78803
Oil Hole
A78804
SST
A78803
EM6535
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2767
14-275
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(d)
Check that the piston pin fits at normal room temperature.
Coat the piston pin with engine oil, and push it into the
connecting rod with your thumb.
27.
(a)
INSPECT RING GROOVE CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
new piston ring and the wall of the ring groove.
Ring groove clearance:
P00326
A78317
Item
Specified Condition
No. 1
0.03 to 0.08 mm (0.0012 to 0.0031 in.)
No. 2
0.02 to 0.06 mm (0.0008 to 0.0024 in.)
Oil
0.03 to 0.11 mm (0.0012 to 0.0043 in.)
If the clearance is not as specified, replace the piston.
28.
(a)
INSPECT PISTON RING END GAP
Using a piston, push the piston ring a little beyond the bottom of the ring travel, 110 mm (4.33 in.) from the top of the
cylinder block.
(b)
Using a feeler gauge, measure the end gap.
Standard end gap:
110 mm
A78805
Item
Specified Condition
No. 1
0.30 to 0.40 mm (0.0118 to 0.0157 in.)
No. 2
0.50 to 0.60 mm (0.0197 to 0.0236 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
0.15 to 0.40 mm (0.0059 to 0.0157 in.)
Maximum end gap:
A37355
Item
Specified Condition
No. 1
0.95 mm (0.0374 in.)
No. 2
1.05 mm (0.0413 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
1.00 mm (0.0394 in.)
If the end gap is greater than the maximum, replace the piston
ring.
If the end gap is greater than the maximum even with a new piston ring, replace the cylinder block.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2768
14-276
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
29.
(a)
INSPECT CONNECTING ROD BOLT
Using a vernier caliper, measure the tension portion diameter of the bolt.
Standard diameter:
7.20 to 7.30 mm (0.2830 to 0.2870 in.)
Minimum diameter: 7.0 mm (0.2760 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the bolt.
EM6347
A15065
30.
(a)
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT BEARING CAP SET BOLT
Using a vernier caliper, measure the tension portion diameter of the bolt.
Standard diameter:
7.50 to 7.60 mm (0.2950 to 0.2990 in.)
Minimum diameter: 7.20 mm (0.2830 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the bolt.
EM6347
A15065
31.
(a)
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT
Using a dial indicator and V-blocks, measure the runout
as shown in the illustration.
Maximum circle runout: 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than the maximum, replace the
crankshaft.
P12406
(b)
A37157
Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of each main
journal.
Diameter: 60.988 to 61.000 mm (2.4011 to 2.4016 in.)
If the diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance (see
step 7).
If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
(c) Check each main journal for taper and out-of-round, as
shown in the illustration.
Maximum taper and out-of-round:
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
If the taper and out-of-round is greater than the maximum, replace the crankshaft.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2769
14-277
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(d)
ZF6928
Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of each crank
pin.
Diameter: 52.992 to 53.000 mm (2.0863 to 2.0866 in.)
If the diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance (see
step 7).
(e) Check each crank pin for taper and out-of-round, as
shown in the illustration.
Maximum taper and out-of-round:
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
If the taper and out-of-round is greater than the maximum, replace the crankshaft.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2770
14-278
ENGINE MECHANICAL
32.
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL STUD BOLT
Front Side
Front Side
99 mm
(3.90 in.)
29 mm
(1.14 in.)
M8
M6
Torque: 6.0 N⋅m (60 kgf⋅cm, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Torque: 15 N⋅m (145 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
Front Side
Left Side
80 mm
(3.15 in.)
28.5 mm
(1.12 in.)
M8
M10
Torque: 21 N⋅m (220 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Torque: 7.0 N⋅m (70 kgf⋅cm, 62 in.⋅lbf)
Top Side
Top Side
52.5 mm
(2.07 in.)
27.5 mm
(1.08 in.)
M6
M8
Torque: 4.0 N⋅m (40 kgf⋅cm, 35 in.⋅lbf)
Torque: 12 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
A78318
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2771
14-279
ENGINE MECHANICAL
33.
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL STRAIGHT PIN
Front Side
Right Side (FF)
4 mm
(0.16 in.)
4 mm
(0.16 in.)
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
Protrusion Height:
6 mm (0.24 in.)
Protrusion Height:
6 mm (0.24 in.)
Top Side
Bottom Side
4 mm
(0.16 in.)
4 mm
(0.16 in.)
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
Protrusion Height:
6 mm (0.24 in.)
Protrusion Height:
6 mm (0.24 in.)
Backside
Backside
4 mm
(0.16 in.)
10 mm
12 mm
(0.47 in.)
Protrusion Height:
6 mm (0.24 in.)
22 mm
(0.87 in.)
Protrusion Height:
11 mm (0.43 in.)
A78319
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2772
14-280
ENGINE MECHANICAL
34.
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL RING PIN
Top Side
Bottom Side
11 mm
(0.43 in.)
16 mm
(0.63 in.)
8 mm
(0.31 in.)
20 mm
(0.79 in.)
Protrusion Height: 10 mm (0.39 in.)
Protrusion Height: 4 mm (0.16 in.)
A78816
35.
(a)
INSTALL PISTON PIN HOLE SNAP RING
Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring at one
end of the piston pin hole.
HINT:
Be sure that the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with the
pin hole cutout portion of the piston.
A32958
P12418
80C
36.
(a)
INSTALL W/PIN PISTON SUB-ASSY
Gradually heat the piston to about 80C (176F).
(b)
(c)
Coat the piston pin with engine oil.
Align the front marks of the piston and connecting rod,
and push in the piston pin with your thumb until the pin
contacts the snap ring.
A78817
Front Mark
Front Mark
(Mold Mark)
A78376
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2773
14-281
ENGINE MECHANICAL
37.
(a)
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL PISTON PIN HOLE SNAP RING
Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring on the
other end of the piston pin hole.
HINT:
Be sure that the end of gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
the pin hole cutout portion of the piston.
A32958
P12418
38.
(a)
(b)
No. 1
2A
INSTALL PISTON RING SET
Install the oil ring expander and the 2 side rails by hand.
Using a piston ring expander, install the 2 compression
rings.
HINT:
The compression ring No. 2 is installed with code mark ”2A”
faced upward, as shown in the illustration.
No. 2
A78320
(c)
Lower Side Rail
No. 2
Compression
Front Mark
Position the piston rings so that the ring ends are arranged, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not align the ring ends.
Expander
No. 1
Compression
Upper Side Rail
A78321
39.
(a)
INSTALL CONNECTING ROD BEARING
Align the key of the bearing with the keyway of the connecting rod or connecting cap.
NOTICE:
Clean the backside of the bearing and the bearing surface
of the connecting rod. The surface should be free of dust
and oils.
P12402
No. 1 and No. 4
No. 2 and No. 3
Upper
Lower
22.4 mm
40. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT BEARING
HINT:
Main bearings come in width of 22.4 mm (0.882 in.) and 19.0
mm (0.748 in.). Install the 22.4mm (0.882 in.) bearings in the
No. 1 and No. 4 cylinder block journal positions with the main
bearing cap. Install the 19.0 mm (0.748 in.) bearings in the No.
2 and No. 3 positions.
19.0 mm
A78806
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2774
14-282
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(a)
Align the key of the bearing with the keyway of the cylinder
block, and push in the 4 upper bearings.
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil to the bearing and its contact surface.
P12599
(b)
Align the key of the bearing with the keyway of the main
bearing cap, and push in the 4 lower bearings.
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil to the bearing and its contact surface.
HINT:
A number is marked on each main bearing cap to indicate the
installation position.
Mark
1, 2, 3 or 4
A78807
41.
(a)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT THRUST WASHER SET
Install the 2 thrust washers under the No. 2 journal position of the cylinder block with the oil grooves facing outward.
(b)
Install the 2 thrust washers on the No. 2 bearing cap with
the grooves facing outward.
P12600
A05264
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2775
14-283
ENGINE MECHANICAL
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
42.
(a)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT
Apply engine oil to the upper bearing and install the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
(b)
Examine the front marks and numbers. Install the bearing
caps on the cylinder block.
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads of the bearing cap bolts.
Temporarily install the 8 main bearing cap bolts to the inside positions.
(c)
(d)
A10530
(e)
Install the main bearing cap by hand using the inner bolt
as a guide. Stop the main bearing cap about 6 mm (0.23
in.) away from contacting with the block.
(f)
Using a plastic-faced hammer, lightly tap the bearing cap
to ensure a proper fit.
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads of the main
bearing cap bolts.
Less than 6 mm
A78809
(g)
A10529
(h)
11 3
15
9 1
7
13
5
6
2
4
8
Uniformly install and tighten the 16 main bearing cap bolts
in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 22 N⋅m (224 kgf⋅cm, 16 ft⋅lbf)
14
10
12
16
A78810
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2776
14-284
ENGINE MECHANICAL
(i)
(j)
Painted Mark
90
(k)
90
Front
(l)
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Mark the front side of the bearing cap bolts with paint.
Retighten the bearing cap bolts by 90 in the same sequence as step (h).
Check that each painted mark is now at a 90 angle to the
front.
Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
A78811
2
1
(m)
4
7
3
HINT:
Use the short bolt for the marked positions (arrow).
6
8
Uniformly install and tighten the 8 main bearing cap bolts
in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 27 N⋅m (275 kgf⋅cm, 20 ft⋅lbf)
5
A91571
43.
(a)
Front Mark (Cavity)
Front
A78322
Front
INSTALL PISTON SUB-ASSY W/CONNECTING ROD
Apply engine oil to the cylinder walls, the pistons, and the
surfaces of connecting rod bearings.
(b) Check the position of the piston ring ends.
(c) Using a piston ring compressor, push the piston that numbered correctly and connecting rod assemblies into each
cylinder with the front mark of the piston facing forward.
NOTICE:
Match the numbered connecting rod cap with the connecting rod.
(d) Check that the protrusion of the connecting rod cap is facing the correct direction.
(e) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads of the connecting rod cap bolts.
Protrusion
A78794
(f)
Tighten the bolts in several steps by the specified torque.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
P12697
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2777
14-285
ENGINE MECHANICAL
Painted Mark
90
90
-
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(g)
(h)
(i)
Mark the front side of each connecting cap bolt with paint.
Retighten the cap bolts by 90 as shown in the illustration.
Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
44.
INSTALL CYLINDER BLOCK W/HEAD STRAIGHT
SCREW NO.1 PLUG
Using a socket hexagon wrench 10, install a new gasket
and the screw plug.
Torque: 30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
Front
A78795
Front Side
(a)
A78822
45.
Left Side
(a)
INSTALL CYLINDER BLOCK W/HEAD STRAIGHT
SCREW NO.2 PLUG
Using a socket hexagon wrench 10, install a new gasket
and the screw plug.
Torque: 30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
A78823
46.
Back Side
(a)
INSTALL CYLINDER BLOCK W/HEAD STRAIGHT
SCREW NO.3 PLUG
Using a socket hexagon wrench 10, install a new gasket
and the screw plug.
Torque: 50 N⋅m (510 kgf⋅cm, 37 ft⋅lbf)
A78824
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2778
14-286
ENGINE MECHANICAL
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY (3MZ-FE)
47.
(a)
(b)
A
A
B
B
-
Seal Width:
3 to 5 mm
A62377
INSTALL WATER SEAL PLATE
Remove any old seal packing from the contact surface.
Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (seal width: 3 to
5 mm (0.12 to 0.20 in.)), as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00100 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Install the seal plate within 3 minutes after applying
seal packing.
Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at least 2
hours after installing.
(c) Install the seal plate with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
48. INSTALL CYLINDER BLOCK WATER DRAIN COCK
SUB-ASSY
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the drain cock end.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(b)
After applying the specified torque, rotate the drain cock
clockwise, as shown in the illustration.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (398 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Install the drain cock within 3 minutes after applying
adhesive.
Do not expose the seal to coolant for at least 1 hour
after installing.
Do not rotate the drain cock more than 1 revolution
(360) after tightening the drain cock with the specified torque.
Do not loosen the drain cock after setting it correctly.
10
45
A78323
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2779
15-1
EXHAUST
-
EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
150AZ-02
COMPONENTS
Front Floor Heat Insulator No. 3
Main Muffler Heat Insulator
Front Floor Heat Insulator No. 2
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
44 (449, 35)
Rivet
Gasket
Gasket
4.9 (50, 43 in.⋅lbf)
48 (489, 35)
Rivet
Exhaust Pipe Support
56 (571, 41)
Gasket
Exhaust Pipe Assy Front
Exhaust Pipe Assy Tail
Exhaust Pipe Assy Center
48 (489, 35)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A85589
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2780
15-2
EXHAUST
-
EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
150CD-01
REPLACEMENT
NOTICE:
Check if an old gasket remains on the pipe. If remains, remove it. Check if any bolts or nuts are rusted.
If rusted, replace them.
1.
(a)
(a)
(b)
(a)
2.
(a)
3.
(a)
(b)
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY TAIL
Remove the 2 bolts and pipe tail from the exhaust pipe
center.
Remove the pipe tail from the exhaust pipe support.
A85593
REMOVE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) connector.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY CENTER
Remove the 2 bolts and pipe center from the exhaust pipe front.
Remove the pipe center from the 4 exhaust pipe supports.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT
Remove the 2 bolts and pipe front from the exhaust manifold.
5.
(a)
Exhaust
Manifold Side
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT
Install a new gasket and the pipe front to the exhaust
manifold with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 48 N⋅m (489 kgf⋅cm, 35 ft⋅lbf)
Gasket
A92682
6.
(a)
(b)
7.
(a)
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY CENTER
Install the pipe center to the 4 exhaust pipe supports.
Install a new gasket and the pipe center to the pipe front with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 56 N⋅m (571 kgf⋅cm, 41 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
Install the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) to the pipe front.
Torque: 44 N⋅m (449 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Before installing the sensor, twist the sensor wire counterclockwise 3 and 1/2 turns.
After installing the sensor, check that the sensor wire is not twisted. If it is twisted, remove the sensor
and reinstall it.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2781
15-3
EXHAUST
8.
(a)
(b)
Tail Pipe Side
(c)
Gasket
-
EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY TAIL
Install the pipe tail to the exhaust pipe support.
Install a new gasket and the pipe tail to the pipe center
with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 48 N⋅m (489 kgf⋅cm, 35 ft⋅lbf)
Install the pipe to the 3 exhaust pipe supports.
A51123
9.
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
If gas is leaking, tighten the areas necessary to stop the leak.
If damaged, replace it.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2782
15-4
EXHAUST
-
EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
150B1-03
COMPONENTS
Front Floor Heat Insulator No. 1
Front Floor Heat Insulator No. 2
Front Floor Heat Insulator No. 3
Main Muffler Heat Insulator
Rivet
21 (214, 15)
Gasket
Rivet
56 (571, 41)
Exhaust Pipe Support Bracket No. 1
Gasket
21 (214, 15)
56 (571, 41)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Heated Oxygen
Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 2)
44 (449, 35)
44 (449, 35)
4.9 (50, 43 in.⋅lbf)
Gasket
Rivet
Exhaust Pipe Support
56 (571, 41)
Exhaust Pipe Assy Front
48 (489, 35)
Exhaust Pipe Sub-assy
Front No. 3
Gasket
Gasket
Exhaust Pipe Assy Tail
Exhaust Pipe Assy Center
48 (489, 35)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A85587
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2783
15-5
EXHAUST
-
EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
150CE-01
REPLACEMENT
NOTICE:
Check if an old gasket remains on the pipe. If remains, remove it. Check if any bolts or nuts are rusted.
If rusted, replace them.
Bank 2, Sensor 2
1.
(a)
REMOVE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
Remove the 2 heated oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor
2).
2.
(a)
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY TAIL
Remove the 2 bolts and pipe tail from the exhaust pipe
center.
Remove the pipe tail from the exhaust pipe supports.
Bank 1, Sensor 2
A85590
(a)
(b)
(a)
3.
(a)
(b)
(b)
A85593
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY CENTER
Remove the 2 bolts and pipe center from the exhaust pipe front No. 3.
Remove the pipe center from the 4 exhaust pipe supports.
4.
(a)
(b)
(a)
(a)
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE SUB-ASSY FRONT NO.3
Remove the 2 nuts and pipe front No. 3 from the exhaust
manifold.
Remove the 2 bolts and pipe front No. 3 from the exhaust
pipe assy front.
(b)
(b)
A85591
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2784
15-6
EXHAUST
5.
(a)
(b)
-
EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT
Loosen the clamp.
Remove the 2 nuts and pipe.
(a)
(b)
(b)
A85592
6.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT
Install 2 new gaskets and the pipe with the
Torque: 56 N⋅m (571 kgf⋅cm, 41 ft⋅lbf)
Tighten the clamp.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(c)
(c)
2 nuts.
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE SUB-ASSY FRONT NO.3
Install 2 new gaskets to the pipe front No. 3.
Install the front pipe No. 3 to the pipe front with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 56 N⋅m (571 kgf⋅cm, 41 ft⋅lbf)
Install the front pipe No. 3 to the exhaust manifold RH with
the 2 nuts.
Torque: 56 N⋅m (571 kgf⋅cm, 41 ft⋅lbf)
(b)
(b)
A85591
8.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY CENTER
Install the pipe center to the 4 exhaust pipe supports.
Install a new gasket and the pipe center to the front pipe No. 3 with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 48 N⋅m (489 kgf⋅cm, 35 ft⋅lbf)
9.
(a)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(a)
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY TAIL
Install the pipe tail to the exhaust pipe support.
Install a new gasket and the pipe tail to the pipe center
with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 48 N⋅m (489 kgf⋅cm, 35 ft⋅lbf)
A85593
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2785
15-7
EXHAUST
10.
(a)
Bank 2, Sensor 2
-
EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
Install the 2 heated oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 2).
Torque: 44 N⋅m (449 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Before installing the sensor, twist the sensor wire counterclockwise 3 and 1/2 turns.
After installing the sensor, check that the sensor wire is
not twisted. If it is twisted, remove the sensor and reinstall
it.
Bank 1, Sensor 2
A85590
11. CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
If gas is leaking, tighten the areas necessary to stop the leak.
If damaged, replace it.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2786
16-2
COOLING
-
COOLING SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
1602Z-09
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
HINT:
The thermostat is numbered with the valve opening temperature is stamped on the thermostat.
P13560
(a)
Immerse the thermostat in water and gradually heat the
water.
(b) Check the valve opening temperature.
Valve opening temperature: 80 to 84C (176 to 183F)
If the valve opening temperature is not as specified, replace the
thermostat.
P00436
(c)
Check the valve lift.
Valve lift: 10 mm (0.39 in.) or more at 95C (203F)
If the valve lift is not as specified, replace the thermostat.
(d) Check that the valve is fully closed when the thermostat
is at low temperatures (below 77C (171F)).
If not closed, replace the thermostat.
10 mm
A91387
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2788
16-3
COOLING
-
COOLING SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
2.
INSPECT RADIATOR CAP SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
If the reservoir cap has contaminations, always rinse
it with water.
Before using a radiator cap tester, wet the relief valve
and pressure valve with engine coolant or water.
When performing steps (a) and (b) below, keep the
tester at an angle of over 30 above the horizontal.
(a)
Radiator Cap Tester
30 or more
Radiator Cap
A51912
Using a radiator cap tester, slowly pump the tester and
check that air is being released from the vacuum valve.
Pump speed: 1 push every 3 seconds or more
NOTICE:
Push the pump at a constant speed.
If air is not being released from the vacuum valve, replace the
reservoir cap.
(b) Pump the tester and measure the relief valve opening
pressure.
Pump speed: 1 push within 1 second
NOTICE:
The specified pump speed should be followed for the first
pump only. It will close the vacuum valve. Once the vacuum
valve is closed, the pump speed can be reduced.
Standard opening pressure:
93 to 122 kPa (0.95 to 1.25 kgf/cm2, 13.4 to 17.6 psi)
Minimum opening pressure:
78 kPa (0.8 kgf/cm2, 11.4 psi)
HINT:
Use the tester’s maximum reading as the opening pressure. If
the maximum reading is less than the minimum opening pressure, replace the radiator cap.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2789
16-1
COOLING
-
COOLING SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
COOLING SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
1602Y-07
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAKS
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are still hot. Pressurized, hot engine coolant and steam
may be released and cause serious burns.
(b) Fill the radiator with coolant and attach a radiator cap tester.
(c) Warm up the engine.
A93960
(d) Using a radiator cap tester, increase the pressure inside
the radiator to 118 kPa (1.2 kgf/cm2, 17.1 psi), and check
that the pressure does not drop.
If the pressure drops, check the hoses, radiator or water pump
for leaks. If no external leaks are found, check the heater core,
cylinder block and head.
2.
CHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AT RESERVOIR
(a) The engine coolant level should be between the ”LOW” and ”FULL” lines when the engine is cold.
If low, check for leaks and add ”Toyota Super Long Life Coolant” or similar high quality ethylene glycol based
non-silicate, non-amine, non-nitrite, and non-borate coolant with long-life hybrid organic acid technology
up to the ”FULL” line. Do not use plain water alone.
3.
CHECK ENGINE COOLANT QUALITY
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are still hot. Pressurized, hot engine
coolant and steam may be released and cause serious burns.
(b) Check if there is any excessive deposits of rust or scale around the radiator cap and radiator filler hole.
Also, the coolant should be free from oil.
If excessively dirty, replace the coolant.
(c) Reinstall the radiator cap.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2787
16-5
COOLING
-
COOLING FAN SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
160PS-02
INSPECTION
1
5
2
1.
(a)
3
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
5
1
2
3
INSPECT RELAY (Marking: FAN NO. 1, FAN NO. 3)
Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard:
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
B60778
1
4
2
4
3
2.
(a)
5
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
5
1
2
3
A87121
INSPECT RELAY (Making: FAN NO. 2)
Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard:
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
3.
(a)
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
Measure the resistance between terminals 1 and 2.
Standard:
Condition
2.29 to 2.6 kΩ
Approximately 80C (176F)
0.300 to 0.327 kΩ
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
NOTICE:
When checking the ECT sensor in the water, the terminals
should be kept dry. After the check, dry the sensor.
30
20
10
5
Resistance kΩ
Specified Condition
Approximately 20C (68F)
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
-20
(-4)
0
20
40
60
80 100
(32) (68) (104) (140) (176) (212)
Temperature C (F)
A91388
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2791
16-4
COOLING
-
COOLING FAN SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
COOLING FAN SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
16030-07
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
HINT:
The cooling fan may rotate when the ignition switch is turned from ACC to ON. This is normal.
1.
CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION WITH LOW TEMPERATURE (Below 83C (181F))
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Check that the cooling fan stops.
If not, check the cooling fan relay and ECT sensor, and check for disconnected connector or wire breaks
between the cooling fan relay and ECT sensor.
(c) Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
(d) Check that the cooling fan rotates.
If not, check the fuses, cooling fan relay, ECM and cooling fan, and check for a short circuit between the
cooling fan relay and ECT Sensor..
(e) Reconnect ECT sensor connector.
2.
CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION WITH HIGH TEMPERATURE (Above 90C (194F))
(a) Start the engine, and raise ECT to above 90C (194F).
(b) Check that the cooling fan rotates.
If not, replace the ECT sensor.
3.
INSPECT COOLING FAN
(a) Disconnect the cooling fan connector.
(b) Connect battery and ammeter to the cooling fan connector.
(c) Check that the cooling fan rotates smoothly, and check the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage: 5.2 to 8.2 A at 20C (68F)
If not, replace the cooling fan.
(d) Reconnect the cooling fan connector.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2790
16-6
COOLING
-
COOLANT (2AZ-FE)
COOLANT (2AZ-FE)
16032-08
REPLACEMENT
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are still hot. Pressurized, hot engine
coolant and steam may be released and cause serious burns.
(b) Drain engine coolant by loosening the radiator drain plug and the engine’s cylinder block drain cock
plug.
HINT:
Engine coolant inside the radiator is drained from the drain hole located on the bottom of the engine under
cover.
(c) Tighten the cylinder block drain cock plug.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
Radiator Cap
Cylinder Block Drain Plug
Radiator Drain Plug
A94378
2.
(a)
(b)
ADD ENGINE COOLANT
Tighten the radiator drain plug.
Add engine coolant into the radiator until it overflows.
Capacity:
Item
w/ Heater (front only)
w/ Heater (front and rear)
Specified Condition
Standard
6.3 liters (6.7 US qts, 5.5 Imp. qts)
Towing
7.1 liters (7.5 US qts, 6.2 Imp. qts)
Standard
7.7 liters (8.1 US qts, 6.8 Imp. qts)
Towing
8.5 liters (9.0 US qts, 7.5 Imp. qts)
HINT:
Use of improper coolants may damage the engine cooling system.
Only use ”Toyota Super Long Life Coolant” or similar high quality ethylene glycol based non-silicate,
non-amine, non-nitrite, and non-borate coolant with long-life hybrid organic acid technology.
New Toyota vehicles are filled with Toyota Super Long Life Coolant (color is pink, premixed ethyleneglycol concentration is approximately 50% and freezing temperature is -35C (-95F)).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2792
16-7
COOLING
-
COOLANT (2AZ-FE)
Observe the coolant level inside the radiator by pressing the inlet and outlet radiator hoses several
times by hand. If the coolant level goes down, add the coolant.
NOTICE:
Do not use plain water alone.
(c) Pour coolant into the radiator reservoir tank until the coolant reaches the full line.
(d) Install the radiator cap.
(e) Start the engine and run the engine for 10 seconds.
(f)
Remove the radiator cap after 10 seconds. Pour coolant if the coolant level is lower.
(g) Repeat steps (d) to (f) until the coolant level remains the same from steps (d) to (f).
HINT:
Perform the procedures above before the engine warms up. A warmed up engine causes the thermostat
valve to open, and the air inside the engine circulates between the radiator and the engine.
(h) Install the radiator cap.
(i)
Warm up the engine until the thermostat valve begins to open.
HINT:
As the engine warms up, press the radiator inlet and outlet hoses several times by hand.
(j)
Stop the engine and wait until the coolant cools down to the ambient temperature. If the coolant is below the full line, add coolant.
(k) Install the radiator cap and check the radiator reservoir tank coolant level. If it is below the full line, add
coolant.
3.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS
(a) Fill the radiator with coolant and attach a radiator cap tester.
(b) Pump it to 118 kPa (1.2 kgf/cm2, 17.1 psi) and check leakage.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2793
16-10
COOLING
-
WATER PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
160PT-03
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
A36661
INSPECT WATER PUMP ASSY
Visually check for drain hole coolant leakage.
Turn the pulley, and check that the water pump bearing
moves smoothly and noiselessly.
If the bearing moves roughly or noisily, replace the water pump
assy.
(c) Visually check the air holes for coolant leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the water pump assy.
if engine coolant has leaked onto the timing belt, replace the
timing belt.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2796
16-8
COOLING
-
WATER PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
WATER PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
1602V-08
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD W/BRACKET (See page 14-24 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-24 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET NO.2 RH (See page 14-24 )
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page 14-5 )
REMOVE GENERATOR ASSY (See page 19-16 )
9.
(a)
SST
(b)
REMOVE WATER PUMP PULLEY
Using SST, remove the 4 bolts and pump pulley.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00700)
Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor wire harness
clamp.
B11275
10.
(a)
11.
(a)
REMOVE WATER PUMP ASSY
Remove the 4 bolts, 2 nuts, bracket and water pump.
INSTALL WATER PUMP ASSY
Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful
not to drop any oil on the contacting surfaces of the water
pump and cylinder block.
HINT:
B11276
(b)
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all the old
packing (FIPG) materials from the gasket surfaces and
sealing grooves.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all loose material.
Using a non-residue solvent, clean both sealing surfaces.
Apply seal packing to the water pump as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
HINT:
0.5 to 1.0 mm
(0.020 to 0.040 in.)
Seal Width:
2.2 to 2.5 mm
A89934
Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 2.2 to 2.5 mm (0.087
to 0.098 in.) opening.
Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes of application.
Otherwise the material must be removed and reapplied.
Immediately remove the nozzle from the tube.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2794
16-9
COOLING
(c)
(d)
-
WATER PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Install the water pump and bracket with the 4 bolts and 2
nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the crankshaft position sensor wire harness
clamp.
B11276
12.
(a)
SST
INSTALL WATER PUMP PULLEY
Using SST, install the pump pulley with the 4 bolts.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00700)
Torque: 26 N⋅m (265 kgf⋅cm, 19 ft⋅lbf)
B11275
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
INSTALL GENERATOR ASSY (See page 19-16 )
INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page 14-5 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET NO.2 RH (See page 14-24 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD W/BRACKET (See page 14-24 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-24 )
INSTALL FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-1 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2795
16-1 1
COOLING
-
THERMOSTAT (2AZ-FE)
THERMOSTAT (2AZ-FE)
160U9-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page 14-5 )
REMOVE GENERATOR ASSY (See page 19-16 )
DISCONNECT RADIATOR HOSE INLET
5.
(a)
REMOVE WATER INLET
Remove the 2 nuts and disconnect the water inlet from
the cylinder block.
A59903
6.
REMOVE THERMOSTAT
Top
10
10
Jiggle
Valve
7.
INSTALL THERMOSTAT
(a) Install a new gasket to the thermostat.
(b) Install the thermostat with the jiggle valve facing up.
HINT:
The jiggle valve may be set within 10 on either side of the prescribed position.
B11281
8.
(a)
Top
INSTALL WATER INLET
Install the water inlet with the 2 nuts, as shown in the illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
A90977
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
INSTALL RADIATOR HOSE INLET
INSTALL GENERATOR ASSY (See page 19-16 )
INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page 14-5 )
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-1 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2797
16-13
COOLING
-
RADIATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
160PV-03
COMPONENTS
Front Fender Apron Seal RH
Fan and Generator V Belt
52 (530, 38)
21 (214, 15)
Generator Assy
12.8 (130, 9)
Radiator Reserve Tank Hose or Pipe
Radiator Support Upper
Radiator Assy
Fan Motor Connector
Radiator Support
Lower
Radiator Hose Outlet
Radiator Hose Inlet
Oil Cooler Outlet Hose No. 3
Oil Cooler Outlet Hose No. 2
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
A90980
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2799
16-14
COOLING
-
RADIATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
7.8 (80, 69 in.⋅lbf)
×6
Radiator Hose Outlet
Fan Assy w/ Motor
Oil Cooler Outlet Hose No. 2
Oil Cooler Outlet Hose No. 3
Radiator Assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
A90978
Radiator Cap
O-Ring
Radiator Tank Upper
O-Ring
Plate Washer
Core
8.34 (85, 74 in.⋅lbf)
Cooler Pipe
14.71 (150, 11)
O-Ring
Oil Cooler Assy
O-Ring
8.34 (85, 74 in.⋅lbf)
Plate Washer
ECT Switch
O-Ring
O-Ring
Drain Plug
Radiator Tank Lower
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A90979
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2800
16-12
COOLING
-
RADIATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
RADIATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
160PU-03
ON-VEHICLE CLEANING
1.
INSPECT FINS BLOCKAGE
If the fins are clogged, wash them with water or a steam cleaner.
Dry with compressed air.
NOTICE:
If the distance between the steam cleaner and the
core is too close, the fins may become damaged.
Keep the following injection distance.
Standard:
A73603
Distance
Steam Cleaner Pressures
300 mm (11.81 in.)
2,942 to 4,903 kPa
(30 to 50 kgf/cm2, 427 to 711 psi)
500 mm (19.69 in.)
4,903 to 7,845 kPa
(50 to 80 kgf/cm2, 711 to 1,138 psi)
If the fins are bent, straighten them with a screwdriver
or pliers.
Never apply water directly onto the electronic components.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2798
16-16
COOLING
-
RADIATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
160PX-03
OVERHAUL
1.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE DRAIN PLUG
Remove the drain plug.
Remove the O-ring.
2.
Part A
Dimension B
SST
Claw
Stopper Bolt
Overhaul Handle
A87082
Tank
SST
ASSEMBLE SST
SST 09230-01010
(a) Install the claw to the overhaul handle, inserting it in the
hole in part A as shown in the illustration.
(b) While gripping the handle, adjust the stopper bolt so that
dimension B is as shown in the illustration.
Dimension B: 0.2 to 0.3 mm (0.008 to 0.012 in.)
NOTICE:
If the stopper bolt is not adjusted, the claw may be damaged.
3.
UNCAULK LOCK PLATE
Using SST, grip the handle until stopped by the stopper bolt to
uncaulk the lock plate.
SST 09230-01010 (09231-01010, 09231-01030)
Lock
Plate
Stopper
Bolt
A93944
4.
(b)
REMOVE RADIATOR TANK UPPER AND TANK
LOWER
Lightly tap the bracket of the radiator (or radiator hose inlet or outlet) with a plastic-faced hammer, and remove the
tank.
Remove the O-ring.
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE OIL COOLER ASSY
Remove the cooler pipe
Loosen the 2 nuts and 2 plate washers.
Remove the oil cooler.
Remove the 2 O-rings from the oil cooler.
(a)
Tap
A93945
A93946
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2802
16-17
COOLING
O-Ring
Cooler Pipe
Oil Cooler Assy
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Plate Washer
Nut
Radiator Tank Lower
O-Ring
(d)
30
-
RADIATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL OIL COOLER ASSY
Clean the O-ring contact surfaces of the lower tank and
oil cooler.
Install 2 new O-rings to the oil cooler.
Install the oil cooler to the lower tank with the 2 plate
washers and nuts.
Torque: 8.34 N·m (85 kgf·cm, 74 in.·lbf)
Install the cooler pipe in the direction indicated by the arrows in the illustration.
Torque: 14.71 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
26.9 mm
(1.059 in.)
A94636
Lock Plate
Lock Plate
Core
A87087
7.
INSPECT LOCK PLATE FOR DAMAGE
HINT:
If the sides of the lock plate groove are deformed, reassembly of the tank will be impossible.
Therefore, first correct any deformation with pliers or similar object.
Water leakage will result if the bottom of the lock plate
groove is damaged or dented. Repair or replace if necessary.
NOTICE:
The radiator can only be recaulked 2 times. After the 2nd
time, the radiator core must be replaced.
8.
(a)
Normal X Twisted
O-Ring
INSTALL RADIATOR TANK UPPER AND TANK
LOWER
After checking that there are no foreign objects in the lock
plate groove, install a new O-ring without twisting it.
HINT:
When cleaning the lock plate groove, lightly rub it with sandpaper without scratching it.
X Twisted
A87088
Tank
CORRECT
(b)
(c)
Install the tank without damaging the O-ring.
Tap the lock plate with a plastic-faced hammer so that
there is no gap between the lock plate and the tank.
INCORRECT
Lock
Plate
A93947
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2803
16-18
COOLING
9.
Part A
(a)
Dimension B
Punch Assembly
SST
(b)
Stopper Bolt
Overhaul Handle
3
7
2
1
6
4
RADIATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
ASSEMBLE SST
SST 09230-01010, 09231-14010
Install the punch assembly to the overhaul handle, inserting it in the hole in part A as shown in the illustration.
While gripping the handle, adjust the stopper bolt so that
dimension B is as shown in the illustration.
Dimension: 8.4 mm (0.331 in.)
A87090
10.
(a)
5
-
8
CAULK LOCK PLATE
Lightly press SST against the lock plate in the order
shown in the illustration. After repeating this a few times,
fully caulk the lock plate by gripping the handle until
stopped by the stopper plate.
SST 09230-01010
SST
Tank
Stopper
Bolt
Lock Plate
A93948
HINT:
Do not tap the areas protruding around the pipes, brackets or tank ribs.
The points shown in the illustration and oil cooler near
here (A/T) cannot be tapped with the SST. Use pliers or
similar objects and be careful not to damage the core
plates.
A93949
A93950
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2804
16-19
COOLING
-
RADIATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(b)
H
Check the lock plate height (H) after completing the caulking.
Plate height (H): 7.40 to 7.80 mm (0.2913 to 0.3071 in.)
If not within the specified height, adjust the stopper bolt of the
handle and caulk it again.
A93951
11.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL DRAIN PLUG
Install a new O-ring to the drain plug.
Install the drain plug.
12.
(a)
SST
(b)
(c)
INSPECT FOR WATER LEAKS
Plug the inlet and outlet pipes of the radiator with SST.
SST 09230-01010
Using a radiator cap tester, apply pressure to the radiator.
Test pressure: 177 kPa (1.8 kgf/cm2, 26 psi)
Submerge the radiator in water.
A93952
Tank
Lock
Plate
(d) Inspect for leaks.
HINT:
On radiators with resin tanks, there is a clearance between the
tank and lock plate where a minute amount of air will remain,
giving the appearance of an air leak when the radiator is submerged in water Before doing the water leak test, first swish the
radiator in water until all air bubbles disappear.
O-Ring
A87096
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2805
16-15
COOLING
-
RADIATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
160UA-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation procedures requiring additional information are included.
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
2.
DISCONNECT RADIATOR RESERVE TANK HOSE OR PIPE
3.
DISCONNECT RADIATOR HOSE INLET
4.
DISCONNECT RADIATOR HOSE OUTLET
5.
DISCONNECT OIL COOLER OUTLET HOSE NO.2
6.
DISCONNECT OIL COOLER OUTLET HOSE NO.3
7.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT UPPER
(a) Remove the radiator support upper with the 2 bolts.
8.
REMOVE RADIATOR ASSY
(a) Disconnect the fan motor connector.
(b) Remove the radiator from the body.
9.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT LOWER
10. REMOVE FAN ASSY W/MOTOR
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and fan from the radiator.
11. INSTALL FAN ASSY W/MOTOR
(a) Install the fan to the radiator with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.⋅lbf)
12. INSTALL RADIATOR ASSY
(a) Install the radiator to the body.
(b) Connect the fan motor connector.
13. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT UPPER
(a) Install the radiator support upper with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 12.8 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9.4 ft·lbf)
14. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-6 )
15. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-1 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2801
16-21
COOLING
-
COOLING SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
16035-09
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
HINT:
The valve opening temperature is stamped on the thermostat.
P13560
(a)
Immerse the thermostat in water and gradually heat the
water.
(b) Check the valve opening temperature.
Valve opening temperature: 80 to 84C (176 to 183F)
If the valve opening temperature is not as specified, replace the
thermostat.
P00436
(c)
Check the valve lift.
Valve lift: 10 mm (0.39 in.) or more at 95C (203F)
If the valve lift is not as specified, replace the thermostat.
(d) Check that the valve is fully closed when the thermostat
is at low temperatures (below 77C (171F)).
If not closed, replace the thermostat.
10 mm
A91387
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2807
16-22
COOLING
-
COOLING SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
2.
INSPECT RADIATOR CAP SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
If the reservoir cap has contaminations, always rinse
it with water.
Before using a radiator cap tester, wet the relief valve
and pressure valve with engine coolant or water.
When performing steps (a) and (b) below, keep the
tester at an angle of over 30 above the horizontal.
(a)
Radiator Cap Tester
30 or more
Radiator Cap
A51912
Using a radiator cap tester, slowly pump the tester and
check that air is being released from the vacuum valve.
Pump speed: 1 push every 3 seconds or more
NOTICE:
Push the pump at a constant speed.
If air is not being released from the vacuum valve, replace the
reservoir cap.
(b) Pump the tester and measure the relief valve opening
pressure.
Pump speed: 1 push within 1 second
NOTICE:
The specified pump speed should be followed for the first
pump only. It will close the vacuum valve. Once the vacuum
is closed, the pump speed can be reduced.
Standard opening pressure:
93 to 122 kPa (0.95 to 1.25 kgf/cm2, 13.4 to 17.6 psi)
Minimum opening pressure:
78 kPa (0.8 kgf/cm2, 11.4 psi)
HINT:
Use the tester’s maximum reading as the opening pressure. If
the maximum reading is less than the minimum opening pressure, replace the radiator cap.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2808
16-20
COOLING
-
COOLING SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
COOLING SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
16034-08
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAKS
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are still hot. Pressurized, hot engine coolant and steam
may be released and cause serious burns.
(b) Fill the radiator with coolant and attach a radiator cap tester.
(c) Warm up the engine.
A93961
(d) Using a radiator cap tester, increase the pressure inside
the radiator to 118 kPa (1.2 kgf/cm2, 17.1 psi), and check
that the pressure does not drop.
If the pressure drops, check the hoses, radiator or water pump
for leaks. If no external leaks are found, check the heater core,
cylinder block and head.
2.
CHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AT RESERVOIR
(a) The engine coolant level should be between the ”LOW” and ”FULL” lines when the engine is cold.
If low, check for leaks and add ”Toyota Super Long Life Coolant” or similar high quality ethylene glycol based
non-silicate, non-amine, non-nitrite, and non-borate coolant with long-life hybrid organic acid technology
up to the ”FULL” line. Do not use plain water alone.
3.
CHECK ENGINE COOLANT QUALITY
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are still hot. Pressurized, hot engine
coolant and steam may be released and cause serious burns.
(b) Check if there is any excessive deposits of rust or scale around the radiator cap and radiator filler hole.
Also, the coolant should be free from oil.
If excessively dirty, replace the coolant.
(c) Reinstall the radiator cap.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2806
16-24
COOLING
-
COOLING FAN SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
160Q0-02
INSPECTION
1
5
2
3
1.
(a)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
5
1
2
3
INSPECT RELAY (Marking: FAN NO. 1, FAN NO. 3)
Check the resistance of the relay.
Standard:
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
B60778
1
4
2
4
3
5
2.
(a)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
5
1
2
3
A87121
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
3.
(a)
P01924
INSPECT RELAY (Marking: FAN NO. 2)
Check the resistance of the relay.
Standard:
INSPECT ECT SWITCH (NO. 1)
Check the resistance.
Standard:
Temperature
Specified Condition
Above 98C (208F)
Below 1 Ω
Below 88C (190F)
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch.
NOTICE:
When checking the ECT sensor in water, the terminals
should be kept dry. After the check, dry the sensor.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2810
16-25
COOLING
4.
(a)
-
COOLING FAN SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
INSPECT ECT SWITCH (NO. 2)
Check the resistance.
Standard:
Temperature
P06722
Specified Condition
Above 93C (199F)
Below 1 Ω
Below 83C (181F)
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch.
NOTICE:
When checking the ECT sensor in water, the terminals
should be kept dry. After the check, dry the sensor.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2811
16-23
COOLING
-
COOLING FAN SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
COOLING FAN SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
16036-08
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
HINT:
The cooling fan may rotate when the ignition switch is turned from ACC to ON. This is normal.
1.
CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION AT LOW TEMPERATURE (Below 83C (181F))
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Check that the cooling fan stops.
If not, check the cooling fan relay and ECT switches, and check for disconnected connectors and wire breaks
between the cooling fan relay and ECT switches.
(c) Disconnect the ECT switch No. 1 connector.
(d) Connect the terminals on the ECT switch No. 1 connector.
(e) Check that the No. 1 cooling fan rotates at a high speed.
If not, check the No. 1 cooling fan relay and No. 1 cooling fan.
(f)
Reconnect the ECT switch No. 1 connector.
(g) Disconnect the ECT switch No. 2 connector.
(h) Ground the terminal on the ECT switch No. 2 wire harness side connector.
(i)
Check that the No. 1 and No. 2 cooling fans rotate at a low speed.
If not, check the No. 2 cooling fan relay, No. 3 cooling fan relay and No. 2 cooling fan.
(j)
Reconnect the ECT switch No. 2 connector.
2.
CHECK COOLING FAN
(a) Disconnect the cooling fan connector.
(b) Connect the battery and ammeter to the cooling fan connector.
(c) Check that the cooling fan rotates smoothly, and check the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage: 8.5 to 11.5 A at 20C (68F)
If not, replace the cooling fan.
(d) Reconnect the cooling fan connector.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2809
16-26
COOLING
-
COOLANT (3MZ-FE)
COOLANT (3MZ-FE)
16038-10
REPLACEMENT
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are still hot. Pressurized, hot engine
coolant and steam may be released and cause serious burns.
(b) Drain engine coolant by loosening the radiator drain cock plug and the engine’s cylinder block drain
cock plug.
HINT:
Engine coolant inside the radiator is drained from the drain hole located on the bottom of the engine under
cover.
(c) Tighten the cylinder block drain cock plugs.
Torque: 13 N⋅m (133 kgf⋅cm, 10 ft⋅lbf)
Radiator Cap
Cylinder Block Drain Cock Plug (4WD)
Cylinder Block Drain Cock Plug
Cylinder Block Drain Cock Plug (2WD)
Radiator Drain Cock Plug
A93316
2.
(a)
(b)
ADD ENGINE COOLANT
Tighten the radiator drain plug.
Add engine coolant into the radiator until it overflows.
Capacity:
Item
w/ heater (front only)
Specified Condition
Standard
Towing
w/ Rear heater (front and rear)
9.4 liters (9.9 US qts, 8.3 Imp. qts)
10.1 liters (10.7 US qts, 8.9 Imp. qts)
Standard
10.7 liters (11.3 US qts, 9.4 Imp. qts)
Towing
11.4 liters (12.0 US qts, 10.0 Imp. qts)
HINT:
Use of improper coolants may damage the engine cooling system.
Only use ”Toyota Super Long Life Coolant” or similar high quality ethylene glycol based non-silicate,
non-amine, non-nitrite, and non-borate coolant with long-life hybrid organic acid technology.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2812
16-27
COOLING
-
COOLANT (3MZ-FE)
New Toyota vehicles are filled with Toyota Super Long Life Coolant (color is pink, premixed ethyleneglycol concentration is approximately 50% and freezing temperature is -35C (-95F)).
Observe the coolant level inside the radiator by pressing the inlet and outlet radiator hoses several
times by hand. If the coolant level goes down, add the coolant.
NOTICE:
Do not use plain water alone.
(c) Pour coolant into the radiator reservoir tank until the coolant reaches the full line.
(d) Install the radiator cap.
(e) Warm up the engine.
HINT:
As the engine warms up, press the inlet and outlet radiator hoses several times by hand.
(f)
Stop the engine and wait until the coolant cools down to the ambient temperature.
(g) Remove the radiator cap and check the coolant level inside the radiator.
(h) If the coolant level is below the full level, repeat steps (c) to (g) until the coolant level stays the same
from step (c) to (g).
(i)
Install the radiator cap and check the radiator reservoir tank coolant level. If it is below the full line, add
coolant.
3.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS
(a) Fill the radiator with coolant and attach a radiator cap tester.
(b) Pump it to 118 kPa (1.2 kgf/cm2, 17.1 psi) and check leakage.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2813
16-30
COOLING
-
WATER PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
160Q1-03
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
P12487
INSPECT WATER PUMP ASSY
Visually check the drain hole for coolant leakage.
Turn the pulley, and check that the water pump bearing
moves smoothly and noiselessly.
If the bearing moves roughly or noisily, replace the water pump
assy.
(c) Visually check the air holes for coolant leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the water pump assy.
if engine coolant has leaked onto the timing belt, replace the
timing belt.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2816
16-28
COOLING
-
WATER PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
WATER PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
1602G-13
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
REMOVE V BELT NO. 1 (See page 14-125 )
REMOVE VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2
REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page 14-173 )
15.
(a)
REMOVE TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
Remove the bolt and timing belt idler.
A05055
16.
17.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER
18.
(a)
REMOVE WATER PUMP ASSY
Remove the 4 bolts, 2 nuts and water pump.
A36739
19.
(a)
20.
21.
INSTALL WATER PUMP ASSY
Install a new gasket and the water pump with the 4 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2814
16-29
COOLING
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
-
WATER PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
Torque: 34 N⋅m (347 kgf⋅cm, 25 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT TIMING BELT (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT TENSIONER ASSY (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2 (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Torque: 54 N⋅m (551 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
Torque: 43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
INSTALL VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
INSTALL V BELT NO. 1 (See page 14-125 )
INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION (See page 14-125 )
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-20 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2815
16-31
COOLING
-
THERMOSTAT (3MZ-FE)
THERMOSTAT (3MZ-FE)
1602F-09
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation procedures requiring additional information are included.
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
2.
REMOVE RADIATOR HOSE OUTLET
3.
REMOVE WATER INLET PIPE
(a) Remove the bolt and inlet pipe.
4.
REMOVE WATER INLET
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and water inlet.
5.
REMOVE THERMOSTAT
6.
(a)
(b)
15
15
Stud Bolt
INSTALL THERMOSTAT
Install a new gasket to the thermostat.
Align the thermostat jiggle valve with the upper stud bolt,
and insert the thermostat into the water inlet housing.
HINT:
The jiggle valve may be set within 15 of either side of the prescribed position.
Jiggle Valve
A51994
7.
8.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
9.
10.
INSTALL WATER INLET
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL WATER INLET PIPE
Install a new O-ring to the inlet pipe.
Apply soapy water to the O-ring.
Connect the inlet pipe to the water inlet.
Install the bolt holding the inlet pipe to the cylinder head.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-20 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2817
16-33
COOLING
-
RADIATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
COMPONENTS
12.8 (130, 9)
Radiator Support Upper
7.8 (80, 69 in.⋅lbf)
160Q3-03
×6
Fan Motor
Connector
Fan Assy w/ Motor
Radiator Assy
Fan Motor
Connector
Radiator Support
Lower
Radiator Hose Inlet
Radiator Hose Outlet
Oil Cooler Outlet Hose No. 2
Oil Cooler Outlet Hose No. 3
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
A90981
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2819
16-34
COOLING
-
RADIATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Radiator Cap
Radiator Tank Upper
Lock Plate
O-Ring
O-Ring
8.34 (85, 74 in.⋅lbf)
Core
Cooler Pipe
14.71 (150, 11)
O-Ring
O-Ring
Oil Cooler Assy
8.34 (85, 74 in.⋅lbf)
Radiator Tank Lower
Radiator Tank Lower
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A90982
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2820
16-32
COOLING
-
RADIATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
RADIATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
160Q2-03
ON-VEHICLE CLEANING
1.
(a)
INSPECT FINS BLOCKAGE
If the fins are clogged, wash them with water or a steam
cleaner. Dry with compressed air.
NOTICE:
If the distance between the steam cleaner and the
core is too close, the fins may become damaged.
Keep the following injection distance.
Standard:
A73603
Distance
Steam Cleaner Pressures
300 mm (11.81 in.)
2,942 to 4,903 kPa
(30 to 50 kgf/cm2, 427 to 711 psi)
500 mm (19.69 in.)
4,903 to 7,845 kPa
(50 to 80 kgf/cm2, 711 to 1,138 psi)
If the fins are bent, straighten them with a screwdriver
or pliers.
Never apply water directly onto the electronic components.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2818
16-36
COOLING
-
RADIATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
160Q5-03
OVERHAUL
1.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE DRAIN PLUG
Remove the drain plug.
Remove the O-ring.
2.
Part A
Dimension B
Claw
SST
Stopper Bolt
Overhaul Handle
A87082
Tank
Lock Plate
SST
Stopper Bolt
ASSEMBLE SST
SST 09230-01010
(a) Install the claw to the overhaul handle, inserting it into the
hole in part A as shown in the illustration.
(b) While gripping the handle, adjust the stopper bolt so that
dimension B is as shown in the illustration.
Dimension B: 0.2 to 0.3 mm (0.008 to 0.012 in.)
NOTICE:
If the stopper bolt is not adjusted, the claw may be damaged.
3.
UNCAULK LOCK PLATE
Using SST to release the caulking, grip the handle until stopped
by the stopper polite uncaulk the lock plate.
SST 09230-01010 (09231-01010, 09231-01030)
A87097
4.
(b)
REMOVE RADIATOR TANK UPPER AND TANK
LOWER
Lightly tap the bracket of the radiator (or radiator hose inlet or outlet) with a plastic-faced hammer and remove the
tank.
Remove the O-ring.
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE OIL COOLER ASSY
Remove the cooler pipe
Loosen the 2 nuts and 2 plate washers.
Remove the oil cooler
Remove the 2 O-rings from the oil cooler.
(a)
Tap
A93953
A94326
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2822
16-37
COOLING
O-Ring
Cooler Pipe
Oil Cooler Assy
Plate Washer
Nut
Radiator Tank Lower
O-Ring
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
30
-
RADIATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL OIL COOLER ASSY
Clean the O-ring contact surface of the lower tank and oil
cooler.
Install 2 new O-rings to the oil cooler.
Install the oil cooler to the lower tank.
Install the plate washer and nut.
Torque: 8.34 N·m (85 kgf·cm, 74 in.·lbf)
Install the pipe.
Torque: 14.71 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
26.9 mm
(1.059 in.)
A94637
Lock Plate
Lock Plate
Core
A87087
7.
INSPECT LOCK PLATE FOR DAMAGE
Inspect the lock plate for damage.
HINT:
If the sides of the lock plate groove are deformed, reassembly of the tank will be impossible.
Therefore, first correct any deformation with pliers or similar object.
Water leakage will result if the bottom of the lock plate
groove is damaged or dented. Repair or replace if necessary.
NOTICE:
The radiator can only be recaulked 2 times. After the 2nd
time, the radiator core must be replaced.
8.
(a)
Normal X Twisted
O-Ring
INSTALL RADIATOR TANK UPPER AND TANK
LOWER
After checking that there are no foreign objects in the lock
plate groove, install a new O-ring without twisting it.
HINT:
When cleaning the lock plate groove, lightly rub it with sandpaper without scratching it.
X Twisted
A87088
CORRECT
INCORRECT
Tap
Tank
(b)
(c)
Install the tank without damaging the O-ring.
Tap the lock plate with a plastic-faced hammer so that
there is no gap between the lock plate and the tank.
Lock
Plate
A87089
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2823
16-38
COOLING
9.
Part A
(a)
Dimension B
Punch Assembly
5
SST
(b)
Stopper Bolt
Overhaul Handle
3
10.
(a)
7
2
4
RADIATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
ASSEMBLE SST
SST 09230-01010, 09231-14010
Install the punch assembly to the overhaul handle, inserting it into the hole in part A as shown in the illustration.
While gripping the handle, adjust the stopper bolt so that
dimension B is as shown in the illustration.
Dimension B: 8.4 mm (0.331 in.)
A87090
1
6
-
8
CAULK LOCK PLATE
Lightly press SST against the lock plate in the order
shown in the illustration. After repeating this a few times,
fully caulk the lock plate by gripping the handle until
stopped by the stopper plate.
SST 09230-01010
SST
Stopper Bolt
Tank
Lock Plate
A93955
HINT:
Rib
Do not tap the areas protruding around the pipes, brackets or tank ribs.
The points shown in the illustration and oil cooler near
here (A/T) cannot be tapped with the SST. Use pliers or
similar objects and be careful not to damage the core
plates.
Bracket
A87103
A93956
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2824
16-39
COOLING
-
RADIATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(b)
Check the lock plate height (H) after completing the caulking.
Plate height (H): 7.40 to 7.80 mm (0.2913 to 0.3071 in.)
If not within the specified height, adjust the stopper bolt of the
handle again and caulk again.
H
A87105
11.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL DRAIN PLUG
Install a new O-ring to the drain plug.
Install the drain plug.
12.
(a)
SST
(b)
(c)
INSPECT FOR WATER LEAKS
Plug the inlet and outlet pipes of the radiator with SST.
SST 09230-01010
Using a radiator cap tester, apply pressure to the radiator.
Test pressure: 177 kPa (1.8 kgf/cm2, 26 psi)
Submerge the radiator in water.
A93957
Tank
Lock
Plate
(d) Inspect for leaks.
HINT:
On radiators with resin tanks, there is a clearance between the
tank and lock plate where a minute amount of air will remain,
giving the appearance of an air leak when the radiator is submerged in water. Therefore, before doing the water leak test,
first swish the radiator in water until all air bubbles disappear.
O-Ring
A87096
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2825
16-35
COOLING
-
RADIATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
160UB-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation procedures requiring additional information are included.
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
2.
DISCONNECT RADIATOR RESERVE TANK HOSE OR PIPE
3.
DISCONNECT RADIATOR HOSE INLET
4.
DISCONNECT RADIATOR HOSE OUTLET
5.
DISCONNECT OIL COOLER OUTLET HOSE NO. 2
6.
DISCONNECT OIL COOLER OUTLET HOSE NO. 3
7.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT UPPER
(a) Remove the radiator support upper with the 2 bolts.
8.
REMOVE RADIATOR ASSY
(a) Disconnect the fan motor connector.
(b) Disconnect the ECT switch No. 1 connector.
(c) Remove the radiator from the body.
9.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT LOWER
10. REMOVE FAN ASSY W/MOTOR
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and fan from the radiator.
11. INSTALL FAN ASSY W/MOTOR
(a) Install the fan w/ to the radiator with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.⋅lbf)
12. INSTALL RADIATOR ASSY
(a) Install the radiator to the body.
(b) Connect the ECT switch No. 1 connector.
(c) Connect the fan motor connector.
13. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT UPPER
(a) Install the radiator support upper with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 12.8 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
14. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page 16-26 )
15. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page 16-20 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2821
17-1
LUBRICATION
-
LUBRICATION SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
LUBRICATION SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
1701Z-09
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
Warm up the engine, stop the engine and wait 5 minutes. The oil level should be between the dipstick’s
low level mark and full level mark.
If the oil level is low, check for leakage and add oil up to the full level mark.
NOTICE:
Do not fill with engine oil above the full level mark.
2.
(a)
Recommended Viscosity (SAE)
5W-30
C -29 -18
F -20 0
-7
20
4
16
40 60
27
38
80 100
A66623
CHECK ENGINE OIL QUALITY
Check the oil for deterioration, entry of water, discoloring
or thinning.
If the quality is visibly poor, replace the oil.
Oil grade:
API grade SL, Energy-Conserving or ILSAC, multigrade engine oil is recommended. SAE 5W-30 is the
best choice for your vehicle, for good fuel economy,
and good starting in cold weather.
3.
REMOVE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY
(a) Disconnect the oil pressure switch connector.
(b)
Remove the oil pressure switch.
4.
(a)
INSTALL OIL PRESSURE GAUGE
Install the oil pressure gauge.
Oil Pressure Switch
B11410
Oil Pressure Gauge
B11411
5.
WARM UP ENGINE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2826
17-2
LUBRICATION
6.
LUBRICATION SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHECK OIL PRESSURE
Specification:
Item
Oil Pressure
Idle
29 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 4.3 psi) or more
3,000 rpm
245 to 539 kPa (2.5 to 5.5 kgf/cm2, 36 to 78 psi) or more
INSTALL OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Remove the oil pressure gauge.
Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the oil pressure switch.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
(c) Install the oil pressure switch.
Torque: 15 N⋅m (153 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
A50082
Do not start the engine for at least 1 hour after installation
of the switch.
(d) Connect the oil pressure switch connector.
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
Adhesive
8.
-
7.
(a)
(b)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2827
17-3
LUBRICATION
-
OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY (2AZ-FE)
OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY (2AZ-FE)
1701X-10
REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
Prolonged and repeated contact of mineral oil with the skin will deplete the skin’s natural fats,
leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains harmful contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
Wear protective clothing and gloves to minimize the length and frequency of contact between
the skin and used oil. If contact does occur, wash your skin thoroughly with soap and water or
waterless hand cleaner. Do not use gasoline, thinners or solvents to wash the skin.
In order to preserve the environment, dispose of used oil and used oil filters only at designated
disposal site.
1.
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
(a) Remove the oil filler cap.
(b) Remove the oil drain plug and drain the oil into a container.
2.
(a)
3.
(a)
(b)
SST
REMOVE OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY
Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228-06501
INSTALL OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY
Check and clean the oil filter installation surface.
Apply clean engine oil to the gasket of a new oil filter.
B11412
(c)
(d)
SST
B11413
4.
(a)
Lightly screw the oil filter into place by hand,Tighten it until
the gasket contacts the seat.
Using SST, tighten the oil filter.
SST 09228-06501
(1) Depending on the work space available, choose
from the following.
If enough space is available, use SST to tighten the
oil filter.
Torque: 17.5 N⋅m (178 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
If not enough space is available to use SST, tighten
the oil filter a 3/4 turn by hand.
ADD ENGINE OIL
Clean and install the oil drain plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2828
17-4
LUBRICATION
(b)
-
OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Fill with fresh engine oil.
Specification:
Item
Capacity
Drain and refill
w/ oil filter change
3.8 liters (4.0 US qts, 3.3 lmp. qts)
Drain and refill
w/o oil filter change
3.6 liters (3.8 US qts, 3.2 lmp. qts)
Dry fill
(c)
5.
4.5 liters (4.8 US qts, 4.0 lmp. qts)
Install the oil filler cap.
CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2829
17-19
LUBRICATION
-
LUBRICATION SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
LUBRICATION SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
17020-12
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
Warm up the engine, stop the engine and wait for 5 minutes. The oil level should be between the dipstick’s low level mark and full level mark.
If the oil level is low, check for leakage and add oil up to the full level mark.
NOTICE:
Do not fill with engine oil above the full level mark.
2.
(a)
Recommended Viscosity (SAE)
5W-30
C -29 -18
F -20 0
-7
20
4
16
40 60
27
38
80 100
A66623
CHECK ENGINE OIL QUALITY
Check the oil for deterioration, entry of water, discoloring
or thinning.
If the quality is visibly poor, replace the oil.
Oil grade:
API grade SL, Energy-Conserving or ILSAC, multigrade engine oil is recommended. SAE 5W-30 is the
best choice for your vehicle, for good fuel economy,
and good starting in cold weather.
3.
REMOVE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY
(a) Disconnect the oil pressure switch connector.
(b)
Using a 24 mm deep socket wrench, remove the oil pressure switch.
4.
(a)
INSTALL OIL PRESSURE GAUGE
Install the oil pressure gauge.
Oil Pressure Switch
A52637
Oil Pressure
Gauge
B04132
5.
WARM UP ENGINE
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2844
17-20
LUBRICATION
6.
LUBRICATION SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHECK OIL PRESSURE
Specification:
Item
Oil Pressure
Idle
29 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 4.3 psi) or more
3,000 rpm
245 to 539 kPa (2.5 to 5.5 kgf/cm2, 36 to 78 psi) or more
INSTALL OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Remove the oil pressure gauge.
Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the oil pressure switch.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
(c) Using a 24 mm deep socket wrench, install the oil pressure switch.
Torque: 15 N⋅m (152 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
A50082
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine for at least 1 hour after installation
of the switch.
(d) Connect the oil pressure switch connector.
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
Adhesive
8.
-
7.
(a)
(b)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2845
17-23
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
170HG-04
COMPONENTS
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Vane Pump Assy
43 (438, 32)
V Belt No. 1
V-Bank Cover Sub-assy
32 (326, 24)
Pump Bracket
Vane Pump V Belt
Front Apron Seal RH
43 (438, 32)
Generator Bracket No. 2
18 (184, 13)
10 (102, 7.0)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Generator Assy
Fan Belt Adjusting Bar Bracket
26 (265, 19)
25 (255, 18)
Compressor and Magnetic Clutch
25 (255, 18)
Compressor Mounting Bracket No. 1
Exhaust Pipe Support Bracket No. 1
Exhaust Pipe Sub-assy Gasket
Front No. 3
25 (255, 18)
Engine Under Cover No. 1
56 (571, 41)
21 (214, 15)
Gasket
Gasket
48 (490, 35)
56 (571, 41)
Exhaust Pipe Assy Front
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
56 (571, 41)
Non-reusable
A92869
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2848
17-24
LUBRICATION
64 (653, 47)
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
23 (235, 17)
Engine Moving
Control Rod
Engine Mountin Stay No. 2 RH
64 (653, 47)
95 (969, 70)
87 (887, 64)
95 (969, 70)
75 (765, 55)
Front Frame Assy
87 (887, 64)
52 (530, 38)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
A90976
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2849
17-25
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Engine Wire Protector
Bushing
Collar
Timing Belt No. 3 Cover
Camshaft Timing Pulley
Gasket
125 (1275, 92)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
×6
Timing Belt Idler Sub-assy No. 2
43 (438, 32)
125 (1275, 92)
Timing Belt
No. 2 Cover
Engine Wire
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Engine Mounting Bracket RH
Timing Belt Idler
Sub-assy No. 1
28 (286, 21)
34 (347, 25)
Crankshaft
Pulley
Crankshaft
Timing Pulley
Timing Belt
Timing Belt Guide No. 2
220 (2250, 162)
×4
Timing Belt No. 1 Cover
Timing Belt
Tensioner Assy
27 (275, 20)
Timing Belt Plate
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
A90975
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2850
17-26
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Oil Pump Assy
43 (438, 32)
Compressor Mounting
Bracket No. 1
20 (204, 15)
O-Ring
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Crankshaft Position
Sensor
25 (255, 18)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Oil Pump Seal
20 (204, 15)
Oil Pan Sub-assy
20 (204, 15)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
20 (204, 15)
20 (204, 15)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
20 (204, 15)
Gasket
20 (204, 15)
37 (379, 27)
Oil Strainer Sub-assy
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Gasket
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
45 (459, 33)
Oil Pan Drain Plug
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Oil Pan Sub-assy No. 2
A92865
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2851
17-27
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Oil Pump Cover
10 (102, 7)
x 10
Driven Rotor
Drive Rotor
Oil Pump Assy
Oil Pump Relief Valve
Oil Pump Relief Valve Spring
Oil Pump Relief Valve Plug
49 (500, 36)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A80109
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2852
17-34
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
170JK-02
OVERHAUL
1.
(a)
REMOVE OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
Remove the plug, spring and relief valve.
2.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the oil pump relief valve
Check that the valve falls smoothly into the valve hole by
its own weight.
If it does not, replace the relief valve. If necessary, replace the
oil pump assy.
A33002
3.
(a)
4.
(a)
INSPECT OIL PUMP COVER
Remove the 10 screws and the oil pump cover.
INSPECT OIL PUMP ROTOR
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the oil pump rotor set and place them into the oil pump body. Check
that the rotors revolve smoothly.
If the result is not as specified, replace the oil pump assy.
(b)
Check the tip clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the drive and driven rotor tips.
Standard: 0.060 to 0.180 mm (0.0024 to 0.0071 in.)
Maximum: 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the tip clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the oil
pump assy.
A33003
(c)
Check the body clearance between the driven rotor and
pump body.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the driven rotor and body.
Standard: 0.250 to 0.325 mm (0.0098 to 0.0128 in.)
Maximum: 0.50 mm (0.0197 in.)
If the body clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
oil pump assy.
A33004
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2859
17-35
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(d)
Check the side clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge and precision straight edge,
measure the clearance between the rotors and precision straight edge.
Standard: 0.030 to 0.090 mm (0.0012 to 0.0035 in.)
Maximum: 0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
If the side clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
oil pump assy.
A33005
5.
REMOVE OIL PUMP ROTOR
Marks
6.
(a)
INSTALL OIL PUMP ROTOR
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the oil pump gear set and
place it into the pump body with the marks facing the
pump body cover side.
A51993
7.
(a)
8.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL OIL PUMP COVER
Install the oil pump cover with the 10 screws.
Torque: 10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the relief valve, and insert the relief valve and spring into the pump
body hole.
Install the plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2860
17-28
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
170JJ-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
(a)
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
Install a new gasket after draining engine oil.
Torque: 45 N⋅m (459 kgf⋅cm, 33 ft⋅lbf)
REMOVE V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
REMOVE VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD (See page 14-149 )
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
REMOVE GENERATOR BRACKET NO.2
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE SUPPORT BRACKET NO.1
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (See page 15-5 )
12.
(a)
SEPARATE COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
Remove the 2 bolts, nut and drive belt adjusting bar
bracket.
(b)
Remove the 2 nuts and the generator bracket adjusting
bar together with the wire harness clamp bracket.
Disconnect the compressor, magnetic clutch connector
and wire harness clamp.
E34923
(c)
A36746
13.
(a)
REMOVE COMPRESSOR MOUNTING BRACKET
NO.1
Remove the 2 bolts and mounting bracket.
A36749
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2853
17-29
LUBRICATION
14.
15.
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAGE SUB-ASSY
REMOVE OIL LEVEL GAGE GUIDE
16.
(a)
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING
Remove the 4 nuts and bolt, and disconnect the engine
mounting insulator FR.
NOTICE:
Do not remove the engine mounting insulator.
A93314
(b)
Remove the 4 bolts, nut and engine mounting bracket
RH.
A52015
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
(a)
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
(a)
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2
REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.1
Using a socket hexagon wrench 10, remove the pivot bolt, timing belt idler No. 1 and plate washer.
REMOVE TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE OIL PAN SUB-ASSY NO.2 (See page 14-173 )
REMOVE OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSY
Remove the bolt and 2 nuts, then remove the oil strainer and the gasket.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2854
17-30
LUBRICATION
29.
(a)
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE OIL PAN SUB-ASSY
Uniformly loosen and remove the 15 bolts and 2 nuts, as
shown in the illustration.
B04136
(b)
Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pan by prying between the cylinder block and the oil pan.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the oil pan
and cylinder block.
B04137
30.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE OIL PUMP ASSY
Remove the 9 bolts.
Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pump by prying between the oil pump and the main bearing cap.
Remove the O-ring.
A51990
31.
(a)
SST
A62376
INSTALL OIL PUMP ASSY
Using SST and a hammer, install a new oil seal. Tap the
surface of the SST with the hammer until the oil seal’s surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
SST 09223-00010
NOTICE:
Be careful not to tap the oil seal at an angle.
Keep the gap between the oil pump body edge and the
oil seal free from contamination.
(b) Apply a small amount of MP grease to the oil seal lip.
(c) Remove any old seal packing material from the contact
surface.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2855
17-31
LUBRICATION
(d)
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Apply a light coat of engine oil to a new O-ring and place
it on the cylinder block.
A36784
(e)
Apply a continuous bead of seal packing (seal width: 2 to
3 mm (0.08 to 0.12 in.)) as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08226-00080 or equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from contact surface.
Apply seal packing to the inner side of the bolt holes.
Install the oil pump within 3 minutes after applying
seal packing.
Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at least 2
hours after installing the oil pump.
B
A
C
Seal Packing
Seal Packing
A
Seal Width
2 to 3 mm
B
C
A90857
(f)
Align the key of the oil pump drive gear with the key way
located on the crankshaft, and slide the oil pump into
place.
(g)
Install the oil pump by tightening the 9 bolts uniformly.
Torque:
8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf) for bolt A
20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf) for bolt C
A94216
A
B
C
A
A
B
A
A
A
A51990
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2856
17-32
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
32.
33.
(a)
INSTALL OIL PAN SUB-ASSY (See page 14-173 )
INSTALL OIL STRAINER SUB-ASSY
Install a new gasket and the oil strainer with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
34. INSTALL OIL PAN SUB-ASSY NO.2 (See page 14-173 )
35. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
36. INSTALL COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH (See page 14-149 )
37. INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAGE GUIDE
38. INSTALL OIL LEVEL GAGE SUB-ASSY
39. INSTALL TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.1
(a) Using a socket hexagon wrench 10, install the plate washer and timing belt idler No. 1 with the pivot
bolt.
Torque: 34 N⋅m (347 kgf⋅cm, 25 ft⋅lbf)
40. INSTALL TIMING BELT IDLER SUB-ASSY NO.2
Torque: 43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
41. INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.3 COVER (See page 14-173 )
42. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
43. INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page 14-173 )
44. INSTALL CHAIN TENSIONER ASSY NO.1 (See page 14-173 )
45. INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE NO.2 (See page 14-41 )
46. INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.2 COVER
(a) Visually check for cracks and breaks on the gasket of the timing belt cover.
If there is a trace that water is entering at the visual check, replace the timing belt cover.
(b) Install the timing belt cover.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
47. INSTALL TIMING BELT NO.1 COVER (See page 14-173 )
A
C
48.
(a)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING
Install the engine mounting bracket RH with the 4 bolts
and nut.
Torque:
54 N⋅m (551 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
54 N⋅m (551 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf) for nut B
43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf) for bolt C
(b)
Install the engine mounting insulator RH with the 4 nuts.
Torque:
95 N⋅m (969 kgf⋅cm, 70 ft⋅lbf) for nut A
87 N⋅m (887 kgf⋅cm, 64 ft⋅lbf) for nut B
B
A
A
A52939
A
B
HINT:
First, loosely install the nut labeled (A) with your hand. Then use
a wrench to install the 3 nuts labeled (B). Finally, use a wrench
to tighten nut (A).
B
B
A52028
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2857
17-33
LUBRICATION
(c)
A
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Install the engine mounting insulator FR with the nut.
Torque:
87 N⋅m (887 kgf⋅cm, 64 ft⋅lbf) for nut A
52 N⋅m (530 kgf⋅cm, 38 ft⋅lbf) for nut B
B
B
B
A93314
49. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-173 )
50. INSTALL GENERATOR BRACKET NO.1
(a) Visually check for cracks and breaks on the gasket of the timing belt cover.
If there is a trace that water is entering at the visual check, replace the timing belt cover.
(b) Install the timing belt cover.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
51. INSTALL COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
(a) Install the compressor with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install the adjusting bar bracket with the bolt and nut.
Torque:25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf) for bolt
52. INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
Torque: 64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
53.
(a)
B
A
A
54.
55.
56.
57.
A
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
Install the control rod and bracket with the 4 bolts.
Torque:
64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
23 N⋅m (235 kgf⋅cm, 17 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
A90268
INSTALL VANE PUMP V BELT (See page 14-125 )
INSTALL V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(See page 14-125 )
ADD ENGINE OIL
CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2858
17-21
LUBRICATION
-
OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE)
OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE)
1701H-10
REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
Prolonged and repeated contact of mineral oil with the skin will deplete the skin’s natural fats,
leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains harmful contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
Wear protective clothing and gloves to minimize the length and frequency of contact between
the skin and used oil. If contact does occur, wash your skin thoroughly with soap and water or
waterless hand cleaner. Do not use gasoline, thinners or solvents to wash the skin.
In order to preserve the environment, dispose of used oil and used oil filters only at designated
disposal site.
1.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
2.
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
(a) Remove the oil filler cap.
(b) Remove the oil drain plug and drain the oil into a container.
3.
(a)
REMOVE OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY
Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228-07501
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY
Check and clean the oil filter installation surface.
Apply clean engine oil to the gasket of a new oil filter.
Lightly screw the oil filter into place by hand, Tighten it until the gasket contacts the seat.
Using SST, tighten the oil filter.
SST 09228-06501
(1) Depending on the work space available, choose
from the following.
If enough space is available, use SST to tighten the
oil filter.
Torque: 17.5 N⋅m (178 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
If not enough space is available to use SST, tighten
the oil filter a 3/4 turn by hand.
SST
A51980
(d)
3/4 turn
A52007
5.
(a)
ADD ENGINE OIL
Clean and install the oil drain plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 45 N⋅m (459 kgf⋅cm, 33 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2846
17-22
LUBRICATION
(b)
-
OIL FILTER SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Fill with fresh engine oil.
Specification:
Item
Capacity
Drain and refill
w/ oil filter change
4.7 liters (5.0 US qts, 4.1 lmp. qts)
Drain and refill
w/o oil filter change
4.5 liters (4.8 US qts, 4.0 lmp. qts)
Dry fill
(c)
6.
7.
5.5 liters (5.8 US qts, 4.8 lmp. qts)
Install the oil filler cap.
CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2847
17-5
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
170JG-02
COMPONENTS
7.0 (71, 62 in.⋅lbf)
Engine Cover Sub-assy No. 1
Fan and Generator V Belt
43 (438, 31)
Vane Pump Assy
52 (530, 38)
21 (214, 15)
Generator Assy
Engine Under Cover No. 1
Front Fender
Apron Seal RH
Exhaust
Pipe Gasket
56 (571, 41)
Exhaust Pipe Assy Front
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
Exhaust
Pipe Gasket
48 (489, 35)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A90974
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2830
17-6
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Ignition Coil Assy
Engine Wire
Ventilation Hose No. 1
Ventilation
Hose No. 2
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Chain Tensioner Assy No. 1
11 (112, 8.0)
11 (112, 8.0)
×2
×8
Timing Chain or Belt
Cover Sub-assy
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Cylinder Head
Cover Sub-assy
Gasket
Gasket
V-Ribbed Belt
Tensioner Assy
43 (438, 32)
×8
52 (530, 38)
60 (612, 44)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Oil Seal
×2
Crankshaft Position
Sensor
25 (255, 18)
Chain Sub-assy
Crankshaft Pulley
180 (1835, 133)
Crankshaft Timing
Sprocket
Chain Tensioner Slipper
19 (194, 14)
TIming Chain
Guide
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Chain Vibration
Damper No. 1
×2
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Oil Pan Sub-assy
Gasket
Crankshaft Position Sensor Plate No. 1
Spring
× 12
No. 2 Chain Sub-assy
Oil Pump Drive
Shaft Sprocket
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
Non-reusable
×2
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Chin Tensioner
Plate
12 (122, 9.0)
Oil Pump Assy
19 (194, 14)
30 (306, 22)
Oil Pump Driven Shaft Sprocket
: Specified torque
A90972
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2831
17-7
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Engine Moving Control Rod w/ Bracket
64 (653, 47)
Engine Moving Bracket RH
Engine Mounting Bracket No. 2 RH
52 (530, 38)
Engine Mounting Stay No. 2 RH
95 (969, 70)
54 (551, 40)
Engine Mounting Bracket (4WD)
×3
34 (347, 25)
64 (653, 47)
75 (765, 55)
64 (653, 47)
95 (696, 70)
64 (653, 47)
87 (897, 64)
Front Frame Assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
A90973
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2832
17-8
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Oil Pump Strainer Set
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Gasket
Oil Pump Relief Valve Plug
Oil Pump Relief Valve Spring
Drive Rotor
Oil Pump Cover
Driven Rotor
Oil Pump Relief Valve
Oil Pump Assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A87112
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2833
17-16
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
170JI-03
OVERHAUL
1.
(a)
REMOVE OIL PUMP STRAINER SET
Remove the 2 nuts and oil pump strainer.
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
Using a socket wrench (27 mm), remove the plug.
Remove the valve spring and relief valve.
3.
(a)
REMOVE OIL PUMP COVER
Remove the 5 bolts and oil pump cover.
B11430
A52074
B11431
4.
(a)
INSPECT OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
Check the relief valve.
(1) Coat the valve with engine oil and check that the
valve falls smoothly into the valve hole by its own
weight.
If it does not, replace the relief valve. If necessary, replace the
oil pump assy.
B11419
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2841
17-17
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
5.
(a)
Driven Rotor
Drive Rotor
B11420
INSPECT OIL PUMP ROTOR
Check the side clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge and precision straight edge,
measure the clearance between the rotors and precision straight edge.
Standard: 0.030 to 0.085 mm (0.0012 to 0.0033 in.)
Maximum: 0.16 mm (0.0063 in.)
If the side clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
oil pump assy.
(b)
Driven
Rotor
Groove
Check the tip clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the driven rotor tips.
Standard: 0.080 to 0.160 mm (0.0031 to 0.0063 in.)
Maximum: 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the tip clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the oil
pump assy.
Drive
Tip
B11421
(c)
Check the body clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the driven rotor and pump body.
Standard: 0.100 to 0.170 mm (0.0039 to 0.0067 in.)
Maximum: 0325 mm (0.01280 in.)
(d) Remove the oil pump rotors.
If the body clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
oil pump assy.
B11422
6.
REMOVE OIL PUMP ROTOR
7.
(a)
(b)
Marks
INSTALL OIL PUMP ROTOR
Coat the drive rotor and driven rotor with engine oil.
Place the drive and driven rotors into the pump body with
the marks facing the pump body cover side.
B11423
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2842
17-18
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
8.
(a)
INSTALL OIL PUMP COVER
Install the pump body cover with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 8.8 N⋅m (90 kgf⋅cm, 79 in.⋅lbf)
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
Coat the relief valve with engine oil.
Insert the relief valve and spring into the pump body hole.
Using a socket wrench (27 mm), install the plug.
10.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL OIL PUMP STRAINER SET
Place a new gasket on the oil pump.
Install the oil strainer with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
B11431
A52074
B11430
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2843
17-9
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
170JH-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
Install a new gasket and the drain plug after draining engine oil.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
5.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT
6.
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD W/BRACKET (See page 14-24 )
7.
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH (See page 14-24 )
8.
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET NO.2 RH (See page 14-24 )
9.
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page 14-5 )
10. REMOVE ENGINE COVER SUB-ASSY NO.1
11. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
12. REMOVE GENERATOR ASSY
13. REMOVE VANE PUMP ASSY (See page 51-8 )
NOTICE:
Do not disconnect the hose.
14. REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSY
15. DISCONNECT VENTILATION HOSE
16. DISCONNECT VENTILATION HOSE NO.2
17. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-41 )
18. SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION (See page 14-6 )
19. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-41 )
20. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (See page 14-41 )
21.
(a)
REMOVE OIL PAN SUB-ASSY
Remove the 12 bolts and 2 nuts.
A64641
(b)
Insert the blade of SST between the crankcase and oil
pan. Cut through the sealer and remove the oil pan.
SST 09032-00100
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surface of the cylinder block and oil pan.
A00019
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2834
17-10
LUBRICATION
22.
23.
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
REMOVE CHAIN TENSIONER ASSY NO.1 (See page 14-41 )
REMOVE V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSY (See page 14-24 )
Engine Hanger
No.1
24.
Engine Hanger
No.2
INSTALL ENGINE HANGER NO.1
A52507
25. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
(a) Attach the engine chain hoist to the engine hangers.
CAUTION:
Do not attempt to hang the engine by hooking the chain to
any other part.
(b) Remove the bolt and disconnect the engine mounting insulator FR.
A52441
(c)
Remove the bolt and disconnect the steering gear return
hose clamp from the frame.
(d)
Remove the 4 nuts from the engine mounting insulator
RH.
Raise the engine and remove the engine mounting insulator RH.
A59901
(e)
A59900
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2835
17-1 1
LUBRICATION
26.
(a)
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Remove the 3 bolts and engine mounting bracket.
A52481
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
REMOVE TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-41 )
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PLATE NO.1
REMOVE CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER (See page 14-68 )
REMOVE CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER NO.1 (See page 14-68 )
REMOVE CHAIN SUB-ASSY (See page 14-68 )
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR SPROCKET
90
33.
(a)
REMOVE NO.2 CHAIN SUB-ASSY
Turn the crankshaft counterclockwise 90, and align the
adjusting hole of the oil pump drive sprocket gear with the
groove of the oil pump.
(b)
Insert a bar (φ 4.0 mm (0.16 in.)) into the adjusting hole of
the oil pump drive sprocket to temporarily lock the sprocket in position. Remove the nut.
Groove
A52508
Groove
A52509
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2836
17-12
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(c)
(d)
Remove the bolt, chain tensioner plate and spring.
Remove the chain tensioner, oil pump drive sprocket and
chain.
34.
(a)
REMOVE OIL PUMP ASSY
Remove the 3 bolts, oil pump and gasket.
B11415
A32684
35.
(a)
INSTALL OIL PUMP ASSY
Install a new gasket and oil pump with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
36.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL NO.2 CHAIN SUB-ASSY
Set the crankshaft key in the horizontal left position.
Turn the cutout of the drive shaft to the top.
(c)
Align the mark links (yellow colored links) of the chain with
the timing marks of the gear as shown in the illustration.
Insert the gear together with chain into the crankshaft and
oil pump shaft.
Temporarily tighten the oil pump drive shaft gear with the
nut.
B11424
Mark Link
Timing Mark
(d)
(e)
Timing Mark
Mark Link
A94198
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2837
17-13
LUBRICATION
Chain Tensioner Plate
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(f)
Insert the damper spring into the adjusting hole, and
install the chain tensioner plate with the bolt.
Torque: 12 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
(g)
Align the adjusting hole of the sprocket with the groove of
the oil pump.
Insert a bar (φ 4 mm (0.16 in.)) into the adjusting hole of
the sprocket to temporarily lock the gear in position. Install
the nut.
Torque: 30 N⋅m (306 kgf⋅cm, 22 ft⋅lbf)
Bolt
Spring
A94215
(h)
Groove
A52512
(i)
90
Rotate the crankshaft 90clockwise and align the crankshaft key with the top.
A36525
37.
38.
(a)
39.
40.
41.
42.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING GEAR OR SPROCKET
INSTALL CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER NO.1
Install the chain vibration damper with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL CHAIN SUB-ASSY (See page 14-68 )
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PLATE NO.1 (See page 14-41 )
INSTALL TIMING CHAIN OR BELT COVER SUB-ASSY (See page 14-41 )
INSTALL V-RIBBED BELT TENSIONER ASSY (See page 14-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2838
17-14
LUBRICATION
-
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
43.
(a)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Install the engine mounting bracket with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 54 N⋅m (551 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
44.
(a)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Raise the engine and install the engine mounting insulator RH.
Install the engine mounting insulator RH with the 4 nuts.
Torque:
95 N⋅m (969 kgf⋅cm, 70 ft⋅lbf) for nut A
87 N⋅m (887 kgf⋅cm, 64 ft⋅lbf) for nut B
A52481
A
(b)
B
B
B
A59900
(c)
Install the steering gear return hose clamp to the frame
with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
(d)
Install the engine mounting insulator FR with the bolt.
Torque: 87 N⋅m (887 kgf⋅cm, 64 ft⋅lbf)
A59901
A52441
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2839
17-15
LUBRICATION
6.0 mm
Seal Width:
3.0 to 4.0 mm
Seal Packing
A94202
9
11
1
8
12
7
OIL PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
45. INSTALL OIL PAN SUB-ASSY
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the contact surface.
Install the oil pan within 3 minutes after applying seal
packing.
Do not start the engine for at least 2 hours after installing.
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful
not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the cylinder
block and oil pan.
(b) Apply seal packing in a continuous bead (Seal Width: 3.0
to 4.0 mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.)) as shown in the illustration,
and install the oil pan.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826-00080 or equivalent
(c)
10
-
Uniformly tighten the 12 bolts and 2 nuts in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
13
6
14
5
46.
47.
48.
49.
50.
51.
52.
53.
54.
55.
56.
57.
58.
59.
60.
61.
4
3
2
A64641
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (See page 14-41 )
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY (See page 14-41 )
INSTALL CHAIN TENSIONER ASSY NO.1 (See page 14-68 )
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSY
INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSY
INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSY
INSTALL GENERATOR ASSY
INSTALL ENGINE WIRE
INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (See page 14-5 )
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET NO.2 RH
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING STAY NO.2 RH
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD W/BRACKET (See page 14-24 )
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (See page 15-2 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
ADD ENGINE OIL
CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2840
18-1 1
IGNITION
-
VVT SENSOR (3MZ-FE)
VVT SENSOR (3MZ-FE)
180BK-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSY
2.
(a)
(b)
3.
(a)
Bank 1
(b)
(c)
REMOVE VVT SENSOR
Disconnect the sensor connector.
Remove the bolt and sensor.
INSTALL VVT SENSOR
Apply a light coat of engine oil to a new O-ring. Install the
O-ring onto the sensor.
Install the sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the sensor connector.
Bank 2
A79541
A78529
4.
A86853
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSY (See page 14-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2871
18-12
IGNITION
-
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (3MZ-FE)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (3MZ-FE)
180BL-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
(a)
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
Remove the 6 screws, 2 clips and under cover.
2.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
Remove the clip, 2 bolts and apron seal.
3.
(a)
(b)
4.
(a)
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Disconnect the sensor connector.
Remove the bolt and sensor.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Install the sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the sensor connector.
A90206
A80512
(b)
A79763
5.
(a)
6.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
Install the clip, 2 bolts and apron seal.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
Install the 6 screws, 2 clips and under cover.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2872
18-9
IGNITION
-
IGNITION SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
18097-02
INSPECTION
NOTICE:
In this section, the terms “cold” and “hot” refer to the temperature of the coils. “Cold” means approximately -10C (14F) to 50C (122F). “Hot” means approximately 50C (122F) to 100C (212F).
1.
INSPECT SPARK PLUG
NOTICE:
Do not use a wire brush for cleaning.
Do not attempt to adjust the electrode gap of a used
spark plug.
(a)
Megaohmmeter
Ground
I39522
Check the electrode.
(1) Using a megaohmmeter, measure the insulation resistance.
Correct insulation resistance: 10 MΩ or higher
If the resistance is less than the specified value, proceed to step
(d).
HINT:
If a megaohmmeter is not available, do the following simple inspection instead.
(b)
B02629
Alternative inspection method:
(1) Quickly accelerate the engine to 4,000 rpm 5 times.
(2) Remove the spark plug.
(3) Visually check the spark plug.
(4) If the electrode is dry, the spark plug is functioning.
Proceed to step 2.
(5) If the electrode is damp, proceed to step (c), (d) and
(e).
(6) Install the spark plug.
(c)
Check the spark plug for any damage on its thread and
insulator.
If there is damage, replace the spark plug.
Recommended spark plug:
DENSO made
SK20R11
NGK made
IFR6A11
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2869
18-10
IGNITION
-
IGNITION SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
(d)
1.0 to 1.1 mm
B02630
B62019
2.
(a)
Check the spark plug electrode gap.
Maximum electrode gap for used spark plug:
1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
If the gap is greater than the maximum, replace the spark plug.
Correct electrode gap for new spark plug:
1.0 to 1.1 mm (0.039 to 0.043 in.)
NOTICE:
If adjusting the gap of a new spark plug, bend only the base
of the ground electrode. Do not touch the tip. Never attempt
to adjust the gap on a used plug.
(e) Clean the spark plugs.
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, clean the electrode
with a spark plug cleaner and then dry it.
Air pressure: 588 kPa (6 kgf/cm2, 85 psi)
Duration: 20 seconds or less
HINT:
Only use the spark plug cleaner when the electrode is free of
oil. If the electrode has traces of oil, use gasoline to clean off the
oil before using the spark plug cleaner.
INSPECT VVT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard:
Temperature
Specified Condition
Cold
835 to 1,400 Ω
Hot
1,060 to 1,645 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
3.
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard:
Temperature
Specified Condition
Cold
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
Hot
2,065 to 3,225 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2870
18-7
IGNITION
-
IGNITION SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
IGNITION SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
1807T-08
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
In this section, the terms “cold” and “hot” refer to the temperature of the coils. “Cold” means approximately -10C (14F) to 50C (122F). “Hot” means approximately 50C (122F) to 100C (212F).
1.
INSPECT IGNITION COIL ASSY (WITH IGNITER) AND PERFORM SPARK TEST
(a) Check for DTCs.
NOTICE:
If a DTC is present, perform a troubleshooting in accordance with the procedure for that DTC.
(b) Check if sparks occur.
(1) Remove the V-bank cover (see page 14-24 ).
(2) Remove the intake air surge tank (see page 14-24 ).
(3) Remove the ignition coils.
(4) Using a 16 mm (0.63 in.) plug wrench, remove the spark plugs.
(5) Install the spark plugs to each ignition coil and connect the ignition coil connectors.
(6) Disconnect the 6 injector connectors.
(7) Ground the spark plugs.
(8) Check if sparks occur at each spark plug while the engine is being cranked.
NOTICE:
Be sure to ground the spark plug when checking.
Replace the ignition coil if given physical impact is given to the coil.
Do not crank the engine for more than 2 seconds.
If sparks do not occur, do the following test:
SPARK TEST
NG
CHECK IF WIRE HARNESS SIDE CONNECTOR OF
IGNITION COIL (WITH IGNITER) IS SECURE
OK
PERFORM SPARK TEST WITH A DIFFERENT IGNITION
COIL (WITH IGNITER)
NG
OK
1. Replace current ignition coil (with igniter) with a different,
functioning ignition coil (with igniter).
Connect securely.
If sparks occur, replace faulty ignition coil
(with igniter).
2. Perform spark test again.
NG
CHECK POWER SUPPLY TO IGNITION COIL (WITH
IGNITER)
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check that there is battery voltage at ignition coil positive (+)
terminal.
OK
CHECK RESISTANCE OF VVT SENSOR
(See page 18-1 1)
Cold
Hot
835 to 1,400 Ω 1,060 to 1,645 Ω
Standard:
NG
Check wiring between ignition switch to
ignition coil (with igniter).
Replace VVT sensor.
NG
OK
Continue on next page
Author:
Date:
2867
18-8
IGNITION
-
Continued from previous page
OK
CHECK RESISTANCE OF CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR (See page 18-12 )
Cold
Hot
Standard:
1,630 to 2,740 Ω 2,065 to 3,225 Ω
OK
CHECK IGT SIGNAL FROM ECM
(See page 05-541 )
OK
IGNITION SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
NG
NG
Replace crankshaft position sensor.
Check ECM (see page 05-394 ).
REPAIR WIRING BETWEEN IGNITION COIL AND ECM
(9) Using a 16 mm (0.63 in.) plug wrench, install the spark plugs.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (255 kgf⋅cm, 18.5 ft⋅lbf)
(10) Install the ignition coil.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
(11) Install the intake air surge tank (see page 14-24 ).
(12) Install the V-bank cover (see page 14-24 ).
Author:
Date:
2868
18-3
IGNITION
-
IGNITION SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
18092-02
INSPECTION
NOTICE:
In this section, the terms “cold”and “hot” refer to the temperature of the coils. “Cold” means approximately -10C (14F) to 50C (122F). ”Hot” means approximately 50C (122F) to 100C (212F).
1.
INSPECT SPARK PLUG
NOTICE:
Do not use a wire brush for cleaning.
Do not attempt to adjust the electrode gap of a used
spark plug.
Megaohmmeter
Ground
I39522
(a)
Check the electrode.
(1) Using a megaohmmeter, measure the insulation resistance.
Correct insulation resistance: 10 MΩ or higher
If the resistance is less than the specified value, proceed to step
(d).
HINT:
If a megaohmmeter is not available, do the following simple inspection instead.
(b)
B02629
Alternative inspection method:
(1) Quickly accelerate the engine to 4,000 rpm 5 times.
(2) Remove the spark plug.
(3) Visually check the spark plug.
(4) If the electrode is dry, the spark plug is functioning.
Proceed to step 2.
(5) If the electrode is damp, proceed to step (c), (d), and
(e).
(6) Install the spark plug.
(c) Check the spark plug for any damage on its thread and
insulator.
If there is damage, replace the spark plug.
Recommended spark plug:
DENSO made
SK20R11
NGK made
IFR6A11
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2863
18-4
IGNITION
-
IGNITION SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
(d)
1.0 to 1.1 mm
B02630
B62019
2.
(a)
Check the spark plug electrode gap.
Maximum electrode gap for used spark plug:
1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
If the gap is greater than the maximum, replace the spark plug.
Correct electrode gap for new spark plug:
1.0 to 1.1 mm (0.039 to 0.043 in.)
NOTICE:
If adjusting the gap of a new spark plug, bend only the base
of the ground electrode. Do not touch the tip. Never attempt
to adjust the gap on a used plug.
(e) Clean the spark plugs.
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, clean the electrode
with a spark plug cleaner and then dry it.
Air pressure: 588 kPa (6 kgf/cm2, 85 psi)
Duration: 20 seconds or less
HINT:
Only use the spark plug cleaner when the electrode is free of
oil. If the electrode has traces of oil, use gasoline to clean off the
oil before using the spark plug cleaner.
INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard:
Temperature
Specified Condition
Cold
835 to 1,400 Ω
Hot
1,060 to 1,645 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
3.
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard:
Temperature
Specified Condition
Cold
985 to1,600 Ω
Hot
1,265 to 1,890 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2864
18-1
IGNITION
-
IGNITION SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
IGNITION SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
18091-05
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
In this section, the terms “cold” and “hot” refer to the temperature of the coils. ”Cold”means approximately -10C (14F) to 50C (122F). ”Hot” means approximately 50C (122F) to 100C (212F).
1.
INSPECT IGNITION COIL ASSY (WITH IGNITER) AND PERFORM SPARK TEST
(a) Check for DTCs.
NOTICE:
If a DTC is present, perform a troubleshooting in accordance with the procedure for that DTC.
(b) Check if sparks occur.
(1) Remove the engine cover No. 1 (see page 14-24 ).
(2) Remove the ignition coils.
(3) Using a 16 mm (0.63 in.) plug wrench, remove the spark plugs.
(4) Install the spark plugs to each ignition coil and connect the ignition coil connectors.
(5) Disconnect the 4 injector connectors.
(6) Ground the spark plugs.
(7) Check if sparks occur at each spark plug while the engine is being cranked.
NOTICE:
Be sure to ground the spark plug when checking.
Replace the ignition coil if given physical impact is given to the coil.
Do not crank the engine for more than 2 seconds.
If the sparks do not occur, do the following test:
SPARK TEST
NG
CHECK IF WIRE HARNESS SIDE CONNECTOR OF
IGNITION COIL (WITH IGNITER) IS SECURE
OK
PERFORM SPARK TEST WITH A DIFFERENT
IGNITION COIL (WITH IGNITER)
NG
OK
Connect securely.
If sparks occur, replace faulty ignition coil
(with igniter).
1. Replace current ignition coil (with igniter) with a different,
functioning ignition coil (with igniter).
2. Perform spark test again.
NG
CHECK POWER SUPPLY TO IGNITION COIL (WITH
IGNITER)
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check that there is battery voltage at ignition coil positive (+)
terminal.
OK
CHECK RESISTANCE OF CAMSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR (See page 18-5 )
Hot
Cold
835 to 1,400 Ω 1,060 to 1,645 Ω
Standard:
NG
NG
Check wiring between ignition switch to
ignition coil (with igniter).
Replace camshaft position sensor.
OK
Continue on next page
Author:
Date:
2861
18-2
IGNITION
-
IGNITION SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
Continued from previous page
OK
CHECK RESISTANCE OF CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR (See page 18-6 )
Cold
Hot
Standard:
985 to 1,600 Ω
1,265 to 1,890 Ω
OK
CHECK IGT SIGNAL FROM ECM
(See page 05-174 )
OK
NG
NG
Replace crankshaft position sensor.
Check ECM (see page 05-32 ).
REPAIR WIRING BETWEEN IGNITION COIL AND ECM
(8) Using a 16 mm (0.63 in.) plug wrench, install the spark plugs.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
(9) Install the ignition coils.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
(10) Install the engine cover No. 1.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Author:
Date:
2862
18-5
IGNITION
-
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (2AZ-FE)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (2AZ-FE)
18094-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSY (See page 14-24 )
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Disconnect the sensor connector.
Remove the bolt and sensor.
A85637
3.
(a)
(b)
4.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Apply a light coat of engine oil to a new O-ring. Install the O-ring onto the sensor.
Install the sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSY (See page 14-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2865
18-6
IGNITION
-
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (2AZ-FE)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (2AZ-FE)
18093-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
(a)
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
Remove the 6 screws, 2 clips and under cover.
2.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
Remove the clip, 2 bolts and apron seal.
3.
(a)
(b)
4.
(a)
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Disconnect the sensor connector.
Remove the bolt, clamp and sensor.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Install the sensor and clamp with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the sensor connector.
A90206
A80512
(b)
A85638
5.
(a)
6.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
Install the clip, 2 bolts and apron seal.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
Install the 6 screws, 2 clips and under cover.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2866
19-1
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTING SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
STARTING SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
190VG-01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT STARTER ASSY
NOTICE:
These tests must be performed within 3 to 5 seconds to
avoid burning out the coil.
(a)
Do the pull-in test.
(1) Disconnect the lead wire from terminal C.
(2) Connect the battery to the magnetic switch as
shown in the illustration on the left. Check that the
clutch pinion gear extends.
If the clutch pinion gear does not move, replace the magnetic
switch assy.
Terminal C
Terminal 50
A60459
Disconnect Terminal C
(b)
Do the hold-in test.
(1) Maintain the battery connections in step (a), but disconnect the negative (-) lead from terminal C.
Check that the pinion gear remains extended.
If the clutch pinion gear returns inward, replace the magnetic
switch assy.
A81044
(c)
Check the clutch pinion gear return.
(1) Disconnect the negative (-) lead from the switch
body. Check that the clutch pinion gear returns.
If the clutch pinion gear does not return, replace the magnetic
switch assy.
Disconnect
A81045
(d)
Terminal 30
Terminal 50
Do the no-load performance test.
(1) Connect the lead wire to terminal C. Make sure that
the lead is not grounded.
Torque: 10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf)
(2) Clamp the starter in a vise.
(3) Connect the battery and an ammeter to the starter
as shown in the illustration.
A60462
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2873
19-2
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTING SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
(4)
Check that the starter rotates smoothly and steadily
with the clutch pinion gear extended. Check that the
ammeter reads the specified current.
Specified current: 90 A or less at 11.5 V
2.
(a)
INSPECT RELAY (Marking: STARTER)
Check the resistance of the STARTER relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
A92673
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2874
19-3
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
STARTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
190RU-03
COMPONENTS
Starter Armature Assy
Starter Commutator End Frame Assy
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Snap Ring
Washer
Starter Commutator End
Frame Cover
Magnetic Switch Assy
7.5 (76, 66 in.⋅lbf)
10 (102, 7)
Starter Yoke Assy
Planetary Gear
Starter Drive Housing Assy
(w/ Clutch & Drive Lever & Center Bearing)
Starter Armature Plate
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A92671
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2875
19-5
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
190RW-03
OVERHAUL
1.
(a)
REMOVE MAGNETIC SWITCH ASSY
Remove the nut and disconnect the lead wire from the
magnetic switch.
(b)
Remove the 2 screws holding the magnetic switch to the
starter drive housing.
Remove the magnetic switch.
Remove the return spring and plunger from the drive
housing.
A79718
(c)
(d)
A79719
2.
(a)
REMOVE STARTER YOKE ASSY
Remove the 2 through bolts, and pull out the yoke together with the commutator end frame.
(b)
Remove the yoke from the commutator end frame.
A79720
A79721
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2877
19-6
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
3.
(a)
REMOVE STARTER AMATURE PLATE
Remove the armature plate from the yoke.
4.
REMOVE STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME
COVER
Using a screwdriver, remove the frame cover.
A79722
(a)
A79723
5.
(a)
Snap Ring
Pliers
(b)
REMOVE STARTER ARMATURE ASSY
Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring and plate
washer.
Remove the armature from the commutator end frame.
6.
(a)
REMOVE PLANETARY GEAR
Remove the 3 planetary gears from the drive housing.
A82440
A81167
7.
(a)
INSPECT MAGNETIC SWITCH ASSY
Check the plunger.
(1) Push in the plunger and check that it returns quickly
to its original position.
If necessary, replace the magnetic switch assy.
A58586
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2878
19-7
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(b)
Terminal C
Terminal 50
Check if the pull-in coil has an open circuit.
(1) Check the resistance between terminals 50 and C.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the magnetic switch
assy.
Below 1 Ω
A79725
(c)
Body
Below 2 Ω
Check if the hold-in coil has an open circuit.
(1) Check the resistance between terminal 50 and the
switch body.
Standard: Below 2 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the magnetic switch
assy.
Terminal 50
A79726
8.
(a)
INSPECT STARTER ARMATURE ASSY
Check the commutator for contamination and burns on its
surface.
If the surface is dirty or burnt, correct it with sandpaper (No. 400)
or a lathe.
(b) Check if the commutator has an open circuit.
(1) Check the resistance between the segments of the
commutator.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the armature assy.
Below 1 Ω
Segment
A58372
(c)
10 kΩ or Higher
Commutator
Check if the commutator is grounded.
(1) Check the resistance between the commutator and
armature coil core.
Standard: 10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the armature assy.
Coil Core
A58373
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2879
19-8
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(d)
Depth
Using a vernier caliper, measure the commutator’s depth.
Specified depth: 3.1 mm (0.122 in.)
Maximum depth: 3.8 mm (0.150 in.)
If the depth is greater than the maximum, replace the starter armature.
A58584
9.
Length
INSPECT STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME
ASSY
(a) Using a vernier caliper, measure the brush length.
Standard length: 9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
Minimum length: 4.0 mm (0.157 in.)
If the length is less than the minimum, replace the end frame
assy.
A76677
(b)
Check the brush insulation.
(1) Check the resistance between the positive (+) and
negative (-) brush.
Standard: 10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, repair or replace the end frame
assy.
10 kΩ or Higher
A79766
10.
(a)
INSPECT STARTER DRIVE HOUSING ASSY
Check the starter clutch.
(1) Rotate the clutch pinion gear counterclockwise and
check that it turns freely. Try to rotate the clutch pinion gear clockwise and check that it locks.
If necessary, replace the drive housing assy.
Lock
Free
A81655
Apply Grease
11.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL PLANETARY GEAR
Apply grease to the planetary gears and pin parts of the
planetary shaft.
Install the 3 planetary gears.
A81656
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2880
19-9
STARTING & CHARGING
12.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Snap Ring
Pliers
-
STARTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL STARTER ARMATURE ASSY
Apply grease to the plate washer and the armature shaft.
Install the armature to the starter commutator end frame.
Using snap ring pliers, install the plate washer and a new
snap ring.
A82440
(d)
Using a vernier caliper, measure the length of the snap
ring.
Maximum length: 5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
If the length is greater than the maximum, replace it with a new
snap ring.
Length
A58810
13.
(a)
INSTALL STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME
COVER
Install the end frame cover to the commutator end frame.
A81178
Key
14.
(a)
INSTALL STARTER ARMATURE PLATE
Align the keyway of the starter plate with the key inside the
field frame, and install the plate.
15.
INSTALL STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME
ASSY
Align the rubber of the end frame with the cutout of the
yoke.
Install the end frame to the yoke.
Keyway
A73991
Rubber
Cutout
(a)
(b)
A79727
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2881
19-10
STARTING & CHARGING
Cutout
-
STARTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
16.
(a)
INSTALL STARTER YOKE ASSY
Align the protrusion of the yoke with the cutout of the drive
housing.
(b)
Install the yoke with the 2 through bolts.
Torque: 6.0 N⋅m (61 kgf⋅cm, 53 in.⋅lbf)
17.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL MAGNETIC SWITCH ASSY
Apply grease to the plunger and the hook.
Hang the plunger hook of the magnetic switch to the drive
lever.
Install the plunger and return spring.
Protrusion
A79728
A79720
(c)
A79729
(d)
Install the magnetic switch with the 2 screws.
Torque: 7.5 N⋅m (76 kgf⋅cm, 66 in.⋅lbf)
(e)
Connect the lead wire to the magnetic switch with the nut.
Torque: 10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf)
A79719
A79718
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2882
19-4
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTER ASSY (2AZ-FE)
190VH-01
REPLACEMENT
NOTICE:
Before changing the starter, check the following again:
Connector connection
Accessory installation
1.
REMOVE BATTERY
2.
REMOVE BATTERY TRAY
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE STARTER ASSY
Disconnect the starter connector.
Open the terminal cap, remove the nut and disconnect
the starter wire.
Remove the 2 bolts and starter.
(a)
(c)
A60064
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
5.
6.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL STARTER ASSY
Install the starter with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 37 N⋅m (377 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
Install the starter wire with the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the starter connector.
INSTALL BATTERY TRAY
INSTALL BATTERY
Install the battery clamp with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in⋅lbf)
Connect the cables to the battery terminals.
Torque: 3.5 N⋅m (36 kgf⋅cm, 31 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2876
19-12
STARTING & CHARGING
-
CHARGING SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
190RZ-03
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
(a) Check the electrolyte quantity of each cell.
Maintenance-free battery:
If it is under the lower level, replace the battery.
Except Maintenance-free battery:
If it is under the lower level, add distilled water.
2.
Except Maintenance-free battery:
CHECK BATTERY SPECIFIC GRAVITY
(a) Check the specific gravity of each cell.
Standard specific gravity: 1.25 to 1.29 at 20°C (68°F)
If the specific gravity is less than the specification, charge the battery.
3.
Maintenance-free battery:
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
(a) After the vehicle has run for 20 minutes, stop the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, and operate the headlight, blower fan and defogger for 1 minute.
(c) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(d) Measure the battery voltage.
Standard voltage: 12.5 to 12.9 V at 20°C (68°F)
If the voltage is less than specification, charge the battery.
4.
CHECK BATTERY TERMINALS, FUSIBLE LINK AND FUSES
(a) Check that the battery terminals are not loose or corroded.
If the terminals are corroded, clean the terminals.
(b) Check the fusible link and fuses for resistance of below 1 Ω.
5.
(a)
REPLACE BELT
B00543
INSPECT DRIVE BELT
Check the belt for wear, cracks and other signs of damage.
If any defect is found, replace the drive belt.
HINT:
Replace the drive belt if the following defects are found:
If the belt has worn out until the wire can be seen.
If the cracks reach the wire more than one place.
If the belt has chunks missing from the ribs.
(b) Check that the belt fits properly in the ribbed grooves.
HINT:
With your hand, confirm that the belt has not slipped out of the
groove on the bottom of the pulley.
CORRECT
INCORRECT
B75171
6.
(a)
7.
(a)
8.
VISUALLY CHECK GENERATOR WIRING
Check that the wiring is in good condition.
LISTEN FOR ABNORMAL NOISES FROM GENERATOR
Check that there is no abnormal noise from the generator while the engine is running.
INSPECT CHARGE WARNING LAMP CIRCUIT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2884
19-13
STARTING & CHARGING
-
CHARGING SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON. Check that the charge warning lamp turns on.
(b) Start the engine and check that the lamp turns off.
If the lamp does not operate as specified, troubleshoot the charge warning lamp circuit.
9.
INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITHOUT LOAD
HINT:
If a battery/generator tester is available, connect the tester to
the charging circuit according to the manufacturer’s instrucBattery
tions.
(a) If a tester is not available, connect an ammeter and voltGenerator
meter to the charging circuit as follows.
Voltmeter
(1) Disconnect the wire from terminal B of the generator
and connect it to the negative (-) lead of the ammeA91025
ter.
(2) Connect the ammeter’s positive (+) lead to terminal
B of the generator.
(3) Connect the voltmeter’s positive (+) lead to terminal
B of the generator.
(4) Ground the voltmeter’s negative (-) lead.
(b) Check the charging circuit.
(1) Keep the engine speed at 2,000 rpm, check the
reading on the ammeter and voltmeter.
Standard amperage: 10 A or less
Standard voltage: 13.2 to 14.8 V
If the result is not as specified, replace the generator.
10. INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITH LOAD
(a) With the engine running at 2,000 rpm, turn on the high-beam headlamps and turn the heater blower
switch to the HI position.
(b) Check the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage: 30 A or more
HINT:
If the ammeter reading is less than the standard amperage, repair the generator.
If the battery is fully charged, the indication will sometimes be less than the standard amperage.
Ammeter
Disconnect Wire
from Terminal B
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2885
19-1 1
STARTING & CHARGING
-
CHARGING SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
CHARGING SYSTEM (2AZ-FE)
1902O-06
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Check that the battery cables are connected to the correct terminals.
Disconnect the battery cables when the battery is given a quick charge.
Do not perform tests with a high voltage insulation resistance tester.
Never disconnect the battery while the engine is running.
Check that the charging cable is tightened on terminal B of the generator and the fuse box.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2883
19-14
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
190VI-01
COMPONENTS
100 A
Generator
Drive End Frame Bearing
Washer
2.3 (23, 20 in.⋅lbf)
x4
Generator Pulley
Generator Rotor Assy
Retainer Plate
110 (1,122, 81)
Drive End Frame Assy
Generator
4.6 (47, 41 in.⋅lbf)
Generator
Brush Holder Assy
5.8 (59, 51 in.⋅lbf)
Terminal Insulator
x4
1.8 (18, 16 in.⋅lbf)
Generator
Rear End Cover
Generator Rectifier End Frame
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A92688
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2886
19-15
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
130 A
Generator
Drive End Frame Bearing
Generator
Bearing Cover
2.3 (23, 20 in.⋅lbf)
Generator Washer
x4
Generator
Rotor Bearing
Generator Pulley
Generator Rotor Assy
Retainer Plate
110 (1,122, 81)
Drive End Frame Assy
Generator
4.6 (47, 41 in.⋅lbf)
Terminal Insulator
Generator
Plate Seal
Generator
Brush Holder Assy
5.8 (59, 51 in.⋅lbf)
x4
1.8 (18, 16 in.⋅lbf)
Generator
Rear End Cover
Generator
Plate Seal
Generator Rectifier End Frame
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A92683
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2887
19-17
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
190VK-01
OVERHAUL
1.
SST (1-A)
SST (1-B)
REMOVE GENERATOR PULLEY
SST 09820-63010 (09820-06010, 09820-06020)
HINT:
Hold
SST (1-A, B)
09820-06010
SST (2)
09820-06020
(a)
Turn
A92680
Hold SST (1-A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST
(1-B) clockwise to the specified torque.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Check that SST is secured to the rotor shaft.
(b) Mount SST (2) in a vise.
(c) Insert SST (1-A, B) into SST (2), and attach the pulley nut
to SST (2).
SST (2)
Insert
SST (1)
A81659
(d)
To loosen the pulley nut, turn SST (1-A) in the direction
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
To prevent damage to the rotor shaft, do not loosen the
pulley nut more than one-half turn.
(e) Remove the generator from SST (2).
SST(1-A)
Turn
A81660
(f)
(g)
SST (1-A)
SST (1-B)
Turn SST (1-B) and remove SST (1-A, B).
Remove the pulley nut and pulley.
Turn
Hold
A81661
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2889
19-18
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE GENERATOR REAR END COVER
Place the generator on the pulley.
Remove the 3 nuts and rear end cover.
3.
(a)
REMOVE TERMINAL INSULATOR
Remove the terminal insulator from the rectifier end
frame.
4.
(a)
REMOVE GENERATOR BRUSH HOLDER ASSY
100 A:
Remove the 2 screws and brush holder.
(b)
130 A:
Remove the brush holder.
(1) Remove the plate seal.
(2) Remove the 2 screws and brush holder.
(3) Remove the plate seal.
5.
(a)
REMOVE GENERATOR COIL ASSY
Remove the 4 bolts.
Pulley
A81662
A81146
100 A
A81147
130 A
A79736
A81148
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2890
19-19
STARTING & CHARGING
GENERATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(b)
Using SST, remove the rectifier end frame.
SST 09950- 40011 (09951- 04020, 09952- 04010,
09953- 04020, 09954- 04010, 09955- 04071,
09957-04010, 09958-04011)
6.
(a)
REMOVE GENERATOR ROTOR ASSY
Remove the washer and rotor.
Turn
SST
-
Hold
A81663
Washer
A81664
7.
(a)
INSPECT GENERATOR BRUSH HOLDER ASSY
100 A:
Using a vernier caliper, measure the exposed brush
length.
Standard exposed brush length: 10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
Minimum exposed brush length: 4.5 mm (0.177 in.)
If the exposed brush length is less than the minimum, replace
the brush holder assy.
Length
A79305
(b)
130 A:
Using a vernier caliper, measure the exposed brush
length.
Standard exposed brush length: 10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
Minimum exposed brush length: 4.5 mm (0.177 in.)
If the exposed brush length is less than the minimum, replace
the brush holder assy.
Length
B16374
8.
INSPECT GENERATOR ROTOR ASSY
(a) Check that the bearing is not rough or worn.
100 A:
If necessary, replace the rotor assy.
130 A:
If necessary, replace the rotor bearing.
A79306
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2891
19-20
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(b)
Check if the rotor has open circuit.
(1) Measure the resistance between the slip ring.
Resistance:
2.3 to 2.7 Ω at 20C (68F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the rotor assy.
Slip Ring
2.3 to 2.7 Ω
at 20C (68F)
A81665
Slip Ring
(c)
Check the rotor for ground.
(1) Measure the resistance between the slip ring and
rotor core.
Standard: 1 MΩ or higher
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the rotor assy.
(d) Check that the slip rings are not rough or scored.
If rough or scored, replace the rotor assy.
Rotor Core
1 MΩ or Higher
A81666
(e)
Using vernier calipers, measure the slip ring diameter.
Standard diameter:
14.2 to 14.4 mm (0.559 to 0.567 in.)
Minimum diameter: 14.0 mm (0.551 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the rotor assy.
Diameter
A75676
9.
130 A:
REMOVE GENERATOR ROTOR BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the bearing cover (outside) and bearing.
SST 09820-00021
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the fan.
(b) Remove the bearing cover (inside).
SST
Hold
A75678
10.
SST
(a)
(b)
(c)
Generator
Pulley
130 A:
INSTALL GENERATOR ROTOR BEARING
Place the generator rotor on the generator pulley.
Install the bearing cover (inside).
Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09820-00031
A75679
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2892
19-21
STARTING & CHARGING
(d)
SST
-
GENERATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Using SST, push in the bearing cover (outside).
SST 09285-76010
A75680
11. INSPECT GENERATOR DRIVE END FRAME BEARING
(a) Check that the bearing is not rough or worn.
If necessary, replace the bearing.
A81155
12.
(a)
REMOVE GENERATOR DRIVE END FRAME BEARING
Remove the 4 screws and retainer plate.
(b)
Using SST and a wooden block, tap out the bearing.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00250), 09950- 70010
(09951-07100)
13.
(a)
INSTALL GENERATOR DRIVE END FRAME BEARING
Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00470), 09950- 70010
(09951-07100)
A81156
Wooden
Block
SST
A81667
SST
A81668
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2893
19-22
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(b)
Install the retainer plate with the 4 screws.
Torque: 2.3 N⋅m (23 kgf⋅cm, 20 in.⋅lbf)
14.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL GENERATOR ROTOR ASSY
Place the generator drive end frame on the pulley.
Install the rotor and washer.
15.
(a)
INSTALL GENERATOR RECTIFIER END FRAME
100 A:
Using deep socket wrench 21 and a press, press in the
coil carefully.
130 A:
Using deep socket wrench 20 and a press, press in the
coil carefully.
A81669
Washer
Pulley
A81670
Deep Socket
Wrench
20 or 21
(b)
A81671
(c)
Tighten the 4 bolts.
Torque: 5.8 N⋅m (59 kgf⋅cm, 51 in.⋅lbf)
16.
(a)
INSTALL GENERATOR BRUSH HOLDER ASSY
100 A:
Install the brush holder.
(1) While pushing the 2 brushes to inside the brush
holder, insert a pin (φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.)) into the
brush holder hole.
A81148
100 A
Pin (φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.))
A79315
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2894
19-23
STARTING & CHARGING
100 A
-
GENERATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
(2) Install the brush holder with the 2 screws.
Torque: 1.8 N⋅m (18 kgf⋅cm, 16 in.⋅lbf)
(3) Pull out the pin (φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.)) from the brush
holder.
Pin (φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.))
A81672
(b)
130 A
Pin
A79736
130 A:
Install the brush holder
(1) Install the plate seal (inside).
(2) Place the brush holder with the pin facing upward.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the generator brush holder installing direction.
(3) Tighten the 2 screws.
Torque: 1.8 N⋅m (18 kgf⋅cm, 16 in.⋅lbf)
(4) Align the pins of the brush holder with the holes of
the plate seal (outside), and install the plate seal
(outside).
17. INSTALL TERMINAL INSULATOR
(a) Install the terminal insulator.
NOTICE:
pay attention to the mounting direction of the terminal insulator.
A81146
18.
(a)
INSTALL GENERATOR REAR END COVER
Install the rear end cover with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 4.6 N⋅m (47 kgf⋅cm, 41 in.⋅lbf)
A81164
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2895
19-24
STARTING & CHARGING
19.
SST (1-A)
SST (1-B)
-
GENERATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL GENERATOR PULLEY
SST 09820-63010 (09820-06010, 09820-06020)
HINT:
Hold
SST 1-A and B
09820-06010
SST 2
09820-06020
(a)
Turn
A92680
Install the pulley to the rotor shaft by tightening the generator pulley nut by hand.
(b) Hold SST (1-A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST
(1-B) clockwise with the specified torque.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Check that SST is secured to the rotor shaft.
(c)
(d)
Mount SST (2) in a vise.
Insert SST (1-A) and (B) into SST (2), and attach the generator pulley nut to SST (2)
(e)
Tighten the pulley nut by turning SST (1-A) in the direction shown in the illustration.
Torque: 111 N⋅m (1,125 kgf⋅cm, 81 ft⋅lbf)
Remove the generator from SST (2).
SST (2)
Insert
SST (1)
A81659
(f)
SST (1-A)
Turn
A81673
(g)
(h)
SST (1-A)
SST (1-B)
Turn SST (1-B), and remove SST (1-A), (B).
Turn the pulley, and check that the pulley moves smoothly.
Turn
Hold
A81661
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2896
19-16
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
190VJ-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
REMOVE V BELT (See page 14-5 )
2.
(a)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(c)
(d)
(d)
(b)
REMOVE GENERATOR ASSY
Remove the bolt, and disconnect the wire clip on the wire
connectors from the generator.
Disconnect the wire clamp from the wire clip.
Remove the cap and nut, and disconnect the generator
wire.
Disconnect the generator connector.
A92678
(e)
3.
(a)
A
B
A92679
(b)
(c)
(e)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(b)
(d)
4.
Remove the 2 bolts and generator.
INSTALL GENERATOR ASSY
Install the generator.
Torque:
52 N⋅m (530 kgf⋅cm, 38 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
NOTICE:
Be careful not to put the wire harness between the engine
and the generator when install the generator.
Connect the generator connector.
Connect the generator wire with the nut, and install the
cap.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 7.0 ft⋅lbf)
Install the wire clamp to the wire clip.
Install the wire clip on the wire connectors to the generator.
A92678
INSTALL V BELT (See page 14-5 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2888
19-25
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTING SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
STARTING SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
190VL-01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT STARTER ASSY
NOTICE:
These tests must be performed within 3 to 5 seconds to
avoid burning out the coil.
(a)
Do the pull-in test.
(1) Disconnect the lead wire from terminal C.
(2) Connect the battery to the magnetic switch as
shown in the illustration on the left. Check that the
clutch pinion gear extends.
If the clutch pinion gear does not move, replace the magnetic
switch assy.
Terminal C
Terminal 50
A60459
Disconnect Terminal C
(b)
Do the hold-in test.
(1) Maintain the battery connections in step (a), but disconnect the negative (-) lead from terminal C.
Check that the pinion gear remains extended.
If the clutch pinion gear returns inward, replace the magnetic
switch assy.
A81044
(c)
Check the clutch pinion gear return.
(1) Disconnect the negative (-) lead from the switch
body. Check that the clutch pinion gear returns.
If the clutch pinion gear does not return, replace the magnetic
switch assy.
Disconnect
A81045
(d)
Terminal 30
Terminal 50
Do the no-load performance test.
(1) Connect the lead wire to terminal C. Make sure that
the lead is not grounded.
Torque: 10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf)
(2) Clamp the starter in a vise.
(3) Connect the battery and an ammeter to the starter
as shown in the illustration.
A60462
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2897
19-26
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTING SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
(4)
Check that the starter rotates smoothly and steadily
with the clutch pinion gear extended. Check that the
ammeter reads the specified current.
Specified current: 90 A or less at 11.5 V
2.
(a)
INSPECT RELAY (Marking: STARTER)
Check the resistance of the STARTER relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
A92673
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2898
19-27
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
STARTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
190S7-03
COMPONENTS
Starter Armature Assy
Starter Commutator End Frame Assy
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Snap Ring
Washer
Starter Commutator End
Frame Cover
Magnetic Switch Assy
7.5 (76, 66 in.⋅lbf)
10 (102, 7)
Starter Yoke Assy
Planetary Gear
Starter Drive Housing Assy
(w/ Clutch & Drive Lever & Center Bearing)
Starter Armature Plate
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A92671
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2899
19-29
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
190O9-04
OVERHAUL
1.
(a)
REMOVE MAGNETIC SWITCH ASSY
Remove the nut and disconnect the lead wire from the
magnetic switch.
(b)
Remove the 2 screws holding the magnetic switch to the
starter drive housing.
Remove the magnetic switch.
Remove the return spring and plunger from the drive
housing.
A79718
(c)
(d)
A79719
2.
(a)
REMOVE STARTER YOKE ASSY
Remove the 2 through bolts, and pull out the yoke together with the commutator end frame.
(b)
Remove the yoke from the commutator end frame.
A79720
A79721
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2901
19-30
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
3.
(a)
REMOVE STARTER AMATURE PLATE
Remove the armature plate from the field frame.
4.
REMOVE STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME
COVER
Using a screwdriver, remove the frame cover.
A79722
(a)
A79723
5.
(a)
Snap Ring
Pliers
(b)
REMOVE STARTER ARMATURE ASSY
Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring and plate
washer.
Remove the armature from the commutator end frame.
6.
(a)
REMOVE PLANETARY GEAR
Remove the 3 planetary gears from the drive housing.
A82440
A81167
7.
(a)
INSPECT MAGNETIC SWITCH ASSY
Check the plunger.
(1) Push in the plunger and check that it returns quickly
to its original position.
If necessary, replace the magnetic switch assy.
A58586
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2902
19-31
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(b)
Terminal C
Terminal 50
Check if the pull-in coil has an open circuit.
(1) Check the resistance between terminals 50 and C.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the magnetic switch
assy.
Below 1 Ω
A79725
(c)
Check if the hold-in coil has an open circuit.
(1) Check the resistance between terminal 50 and the
switch body.
Standard: Below 2 Ω
If the the result is not as specified, replace the magnetic switch
assy.
Body
Below 2 Ω
Terminal 50
A79726
8.
(a)
INSPECT STARTER ARMATURE ASSY
Check the commutator for contamination and burns on its
surface.
If the surface is dirty or burnt, correct it with sandpaper (No. 400)
or a lathe.
(b) Check if the commutator has an open circuit.
(1) Check the resistance between the segments of the
commutator.
Standard: Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the armature assy.
Below 1 Ω
Segment
A58372
(c)
10 kΩ or Higher
Commutator
Check if the commutator is grounded.
(1) Check the resistance between the commutator and
armature coil core.
Standard: 10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the armature assy.
Coil Core
A58373
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2903
19-32
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(d)
Depth
Using a vernier caliper, measure the commutator’s depth.
Specified depth: 3.1 mm (0.122 in.)
Maximum depth: 3.8 mm (0.150 in.)
If the depth is greater than the maximum, replace the starter armature.
A58584
9.
Length
INSPECT STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME
ASSY
(a) Using a vernier caliper, measure the brush length.
Standard length: 9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
Minimum length: 4.0 mm (0.157 in.)
If the length is less than the minimum, replace the end frame
assy.
A76677
(b)
Check the brush insulation.
(1) Check the resistance between the positive (+) and
negative (-) brush.
Standard: 10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, repair or replace the end frame
assy.
10 kΩ or Higher
A79766
10.
(a)
INSPECT STARTER DRIVE HOUSING ASSY
Check the starter clutch.
(1) Rotate the clutch pinion gear counterclockwise and
check that it turns freely. Try to rotate the clutch pinion gear clockwise and check that it locks.
If necessary, replace the drive housing assy.
Lock
Free
A81655
Apply Grease
11.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL PLANETARY GEAR
Apply grease to the planetary gears and pin parts of the
planetary shaft.
Install the 3 planetary gears.
A81656
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2904
19-33
STARTING & CHARGING
12.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Snap Ring
Pliers
-
STARTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL STARTER ARMATURE ASSY
Apply grease to the plate washer and the armature shaft.
Install the armature to the starter commutator end frame.
Using snap ring pliers, install the plate washer and a new
snap ring.
A82440
(d)
Using a vernier caliper, measure the length of the snap
ring.
Maximum length: 5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
If the length is greater than the maximum, replace it with a new
snap ring.
Length
A58810
13.
(a)
INSTALL STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME
COVER
Install the end frame cover to the commutator end frame.
A81178
Key
14.
(a)
INSTALL STARTER ARMATURE PLATE
Align the keyway of the starter plate with the key inside the
yoke, and install the plate.
15.
INSTALL STARTER COMMUTATOR END FRAME
ASSY
Align the rubber of the end frame with the cutout of the
yoke.
Install the end frame to the yoke.
keyway
A73991
Rubber
Cutout
(a)
(b)
A79727
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2905
19-34
STARTING & CHARGING
Cutout
-
STARTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
16.
(a)
INSTALL STARTER YOKE ASSY
Align the protrusion of the yoke with the cutout of the drive
housing.
(b)
Install the yoke with the 2 through bolts.
Torque: 6.0 N⋅m (61 kgf⋅cm, 53 in.⋅lbf)
17.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL MAGNETIC SWITCH ASSY
Apply grease to the plunger and the hook.
Hang the plunger hook of the magnetic switch to the drive
lever.
Install the plunger and return spring.
Protrusion
A79728
A79720
(c)
A79729
(d)
Install the magnetic switch with the 2 screws.
Torque: 7.5 N⋅m (76 kgf⋅cm, 66 in.⋅lbf)
(e)
Connect the lead wire to the magnetic switch with the nut.
Torque: 10 N⋅m (102 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf)
A79719
A79718
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2906
19-28
STARTING & CHARGING
-
STARTER ASSY (3MZ-FE)
190VM-01
REPLACEMENT
NOTICE:
Before changing the starter, check the following again:
Connector connection
Accessory installation
1.
REMOVE BATTERY
2.
REMOVE BATTERY TRAY
Terminal Cap
(b)
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE STARTER ASSY
Disconnect the starter connector.
Open the terminal cap, remove the nut and disconnect
the starter wire.
(c)
4.
(a)
Remove the 2 bolts and starter.
INSTALL STARTER ASSY
Install the starter with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 37 N⋅m (377 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
(b)
Install the terminal nut and cover the nut with the cap.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 7 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the starter wire.
(a)
A78527
A78528
Terminal Cap
(b)
(c)
(c)
A78527
5.
6.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL BATTERY TRAY
INSTALL BATTERY
Install the battery clamp with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the cables to the battery terminals.
Torque: 3.5 N⋅m (36 kgf⋅cm, 31 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2900
19-36
STARTING & CHARGING
-
CHARGING SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
190SA-03
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
(a) Check the electrolyte quantity of each cell.
Maintenance-free battery:
If it is under the lower level, replace the battery.
Except Maintenance-free battery:
If it is under the lower level, add distilled water.
2.
Except Maintenance-free battery:
CHECK BATTERY SPECIFIC GRAVITY
(a) Check the specific gravity of each cell.
Standard specific gravity: 1.25 to 1.29 at 20°C (68°F)
If the specific gravity is less than the specification, charge the battery.
3.
Maintenance-free battery:
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
(a) After the vehicle has run for 20 minutes, stop the engine.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON, and operate the headlight, blower fan and defogger for 1 minute.
(c) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(d) Measure the battery voltage.
Standard voltage: 12.5 to 12.9 V at 20°C (68°F)
If the voltage is less than specification, charge the battery.
4.
CHECK BATTERY TERMINALS, FUSIBLE LINK AND FUSES
(a) Check that the battery terminals are not loose or corroded.
If the terminals are corroded, clean the terminals.
(b) Check the fusible link and fuses for resistance of below 1 Ω.
5.
(a)
REPLACE BELT
B00543
INSPECT DRIVE BELT
Check the belt for wear, cracks and other signs of damage.
If any defect is found, replace the drive belt.
HINT:
Replace the drive belt if the following defects are found:
If the belt has worn out until the wire can be seen.
If the cracks reach the wire more than one place.
If the belt has chunks missing from the ribs.
(b) Check that the belt fits properly in the ribbed grooves.
HINT:
With your hand, confirm that the belt has not slipped out of the
groove on the bottom of the pulley.
CORRECT
INCORRECT
B75171
6.
(a)
7.
(a)
8.
VISUALLY CHECK GENERATOR WIRING
Check that the wiring is in good condition.
LISTEN FOR ABNORMAL NOISES FROM GENERATOR
Check that there is no abnormal noise from the generator while the engine is running.
INSPECT CHARGE WARNING LAMP CIRCUIT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2908
19-37
STARTING & CHARGING
-
CHARGING SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON. Check that the charge warning lamp turns on.
(b) Start the engine and check that the lamp turns off.
If the lamp does not operate as specified, troubleshoot the charge warning lamp circuit.
9.
INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITHOUT LOAD
HINT:
If a battery/generator tester is available, connect the tester to
the charging circuit according to the manufacturer’s instrucBattery
tions.
(a) If a tester is not available, connect an ammeter and voltmeter to the charging circuit as follows.
Generator
Voltmeter
(1) Disconnect the wire from terminal B of the generator
and connect it to the negative (-) lead of the ammeA91071
ter.
(2) Connect the ammeter’s positive (+) lead to terminal
B of the generator.
(3) Connect the voltmeter’s positive (+) lead to terminal
B of the generator.
(4) Ground the voltmeter’s negative (-) lead.
(b) Check the charging circuit.
(1) Keep the engine speed at 2,000 rpm, check the
reading on the ammeter and voltmeter.
Standard amperage: 10 A or less
Standard voltage: 13.2 to 14.8 V
If the result is not as specified, replace the generator.
10. INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITH LOAD
(a) With the engine running at 2,000 rpm, turn on the high-beam headlamps and turn the heater blower
switch to the HI position.
(b) Check the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage: 30 A or more
HINT:
If the ammeter reading is less than the standard amperage, repair the generator.
If the battery is fully charged, the indication will sometimes be less than the standard amperage.
Ammeter
Disconnect Wire
from Terminal B
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2909
19-35
STARTING & CHARGING
-
CHARGING SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
CHARGING SYSTEM (3MZ-FE)
190NY-04
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
Check that the battery cables are connected to the correct terminals.
Disconnect the battery cables when the battery is given a quick charge.
Do not perform tests with a high voltage insulation resistance tester.
Never disconnect the battery while the engine is running.
Check that the charging cable is tightened on terminal B of the generator and the fuse box.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2907
19-38
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
190VN-01
COMPONENTS
100 A
Generator
Drive End Frame Bearing
Washer
2.3 (23, 20 in.⋅lbf)
x4
Generator Pulley
Generator Rotor Assy
Retainer Plate
110 (1,122, 81)
Drive End Frame Assy
Generator
4.6 (47, 41 in.⋅lbf)
Generator
Brush Holder Assy
5.8 (59, 51 in.⋅lbf)
Terminal Insulator
x4
1.8 (18, 16 in.⋅lbf)
Generator
Rear End Cover
Generator Rectifier End Frame
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A92688
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2910
19-39
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
130 A
Generator
Drive End Frame Bearing
Generator
Bearing Cover
2.3 (23, 20 in.⋅lbf)
Generator Washer
x4
Generator
Rotor Bearing
Generator Pulley
Generator Rotor Assy
Retainer Plate
110 (1,122, 81)
Drive End Frame Assy
Generator
4.6 (47, 41 in.⋅lbf)
Terminal Insulator
Generator
Plate Seal
Generator
Brush Holder Assy
5.8 (59, 51 in.⋅lbf)
x4
1.8 (18, 16 in.⋅lbf)
Generator
Rear End Cover
Generator
Plate Seal
Generator Rectifier End Frame
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A92683
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2911
19-42
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
190VO-01
OVERHAUL
1.
SST (1-A)
SST (1-B)
REMOVE GENERATOR PULLEY
SST 09820-63010 (09820-06010, 09820-06020)
HINT:
Hold
SST (1-A, B)
09820-06010
SST (2)
09820-06020
(a)
Turn
A92680
Hold SST (1-A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST
(1-B) clockwise to the specified torque.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Check that SST is secured to the rotor shaft.
(b) Mount SST (2) in a vise.
(c) Insert SST (1-A, B) into SST (2), and attach the pulley nut
to SST (2).
SST (2)
Insert
SST (1)
A81659
(d)
To loosen the pulley nut, turn SST (1-A) in the direction
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
To prevent damage to the rotor shaft, do not loosen the
pulley nut more than one-half turn.
(e) Remove the generator from SST (2).
SST(1-A)
Turn
A81660
(f)
(g)
SST (1-A)
SST (1-B)
Turn SST (1-B) and remove SST (1-A, B).
Remove the pulley nut and pulley.
Turn
Hold
A81661
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2914
19-43
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE GENERATOR REAR END COVER
Place the generator on the pulley.
Remove the 3 nuts and rear end cover.
3.
(a)
REMOVE TERMINAL INSULATOR
Remove the terminal insulator from the rectifier end
frame.
4.
(a)
REMOVE GENERATOR BRUSH HOLDER ASSY
100 A:
Remove the 2 screws and brush holder.
(b)
130 A:
Remove the brush holder.
(1) Remove the plate seal.
(2) Remove the 2 screws and brush holder.
(3) Remove the plate seal.
5.
(a)
REMOVE GENERATOR RECTIFIER END FRAME
Remove the 4 bolts.
Pulley
A81662
A81146
100 A
A81147
130 A
A79736
A81148
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2915
19-44
STARTING & CHARGING
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(b)
Using SST, remove the rectifier end frame.
SST 09950- 40011 (09951- 04020, 09952- 04010,
09953- 04020, 09954- 04010, 09955- 04071,
09957-04010, 09958-04011)
6.
(a)
REMOVE GENERATOR ROTOR ASSY
Remove the washer and rotor.
Turn
SST
-
Hold
A81663
Washer
A81664
7.
(a)
INSPECT GENERATOR BRUSH HOLDER ASSY
100 A:
Using a vernier caliper, measure the exposed brush
length.
Standard exposed brush length: 10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
Minimum exposed brush length: 4.5 mm (0.177 in.)
If the exposed brush length is less than the minimum, replace
the brush holder assy.
Length
A79305
(b)
130 A:
Using a vernier caliper, measure the exposed brush
length.
Standard exposed brush length: 10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
Minimum exposed brush length: 4.5 mm (0.177 in.)
If the exposed brush length is less than the minimum, replace
the brush holder assy.
Length
B16374
8.
INSPECT GENERATOR ROTOR ASSY
(a) Check that the bearing is not rough or worn.
100 A:
If necessary, replace the rotor assy.
130 A:
If necessary, replace the rotor bearing.
A79306
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2916
19-45
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(b)
Check if the rotor has open circuit.
(1) Measure the resistance between the slip ring.
Resistance:
2.3 to 2.7 Ω at 20C (68F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the generator rotor.
Slip Ring
2.3 to 2.7 Ω
at 20C (68F)
A81665
Slip Ring
(c)
Check the rotor for ground.
(1) Measure the resistance between the slip ring and
rotor core.
Standard: 1 MΩ or higher
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the rotor assy.
(d) Check that the slip rings are not rough or scored.
If rough or scored, replace the rotor assy.
Rotor Core
1 MΩ or Higher
A81666
(e)
Using vernier calipers, measure the slip ring diameter.
Standard diameter:
14.2 to 14.4 mm (0.559 to 0.567 in.)
Minimum diameter: 14.0 mm (0.551 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the rotor assy.
Diameter
A75676
9.
130 A:
REMOVE GENERATOR ROTOR BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the bearing cover (outside) and bearing.
SST 09820-00021
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the fan.
(b) Remove the bearing cover (inside).
SST
Hold
A75678
10.
SST
(a)
(b)
(c)
Generator
Pulley
130 A:
INSTALL GENERATOR ROTOR BEARING
Place the generator rotor on the generator pulley.
Install the bearing cover (inside).
Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09820-00031
A75679
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2917
19-46
STARTING & CHARGING
(d)
SST
-
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Using SST, push in the bearing cover (outside).
SST 09285-76010
A75680
11. INSPECT GENERATOR DRIVE END FRAME BEARING
(a) Check that the bearing is not rough or worn.
If necessary, replace the bearing.
A81155
12.
(a)
REMOVE GENERATOR DRIVE END FRAME BEARING
Remove the 4 screws and retainer plate.
(b)
Using SST and a wooden block, tap out the bearing.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00250), 09950- 70010
(09951-07100)
13.
(a)
INSTALL GENERATOR DRIVE END FRAME BEARING
Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00470), 09950- 70010
(09951-07100)
A81156
Wooden
Block
SST
A81667
SST
A81668
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2918
19-47
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(b)
Install the retainer plate with the 4 screws.
Torque: 2.3 N⋅m (23 kgf⋅cm, 20 in.⋅lbf)
14.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL GENERATOR ROTOR ASSY
Place the drive end frame on the pulley.
Install the rotor and washer.
15.
(a)
INSTALL GENERATOR RECTIFIER END FRAME
100 A:
Using deep socket wrench 21 and a press, press in the
coil carefully.
130 A:
Using deep socket wrench 20 and a press, press in the
coil carefully.
A81156
Washer
Pulley
A81670
Deep Socket
Wrench
20 or 21
(b)
A81671
(c)
Tighten the 4 bolts.
Torque: 5.8 N⋅m (59 kgf⋅cm, 51 in.⋅lbf)
16.
(a)
INSTALL GENERATOR BRUSH HOLDER ASSY
100 A:
Install the brush holder.
(1) While pushing the 2 brushes to inside the brush
holder, insert a pin (φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.)) into the
brush holder hole.
A81148
100 A
Pin (φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.))
A79315
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2919
19-48
STARTING & CHARGING
100 A
-
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(2) Install the generator brush holder with the 2 screws.
Torque: 1.8 N⋅m (18 kgf⋅cm, 16 in.⋅lbf)
(3) Pull out the pin (φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.)) from the generator brush holder.
Pin (φ1.0 mm (0.039 in.))
A81672
130 A
(b)
Pin
A79736
130 A:
Install the brush holder.
(1) Install the plate seal (inside).
(2) Place the brush holder with the pin facing upward.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the generator brush holder installing direction.
(3) Tighten the 2 screws.
Torque: 1.8 N⋅m (18 kgf⋅cm, 16 in.⋅lbf)
(4) Align the pins of the brush holder with the holes of
the plate seal (outside), and install the plate seal
(outside).
17. INSTALL TERMINAL INSULATOR
(a) Install the terminal insulator.
NOTICE:
pay attention to the mounting direction of the terminal insulator.
A81146
18.
(a)
INSTALL GENERATOR REAR END COVER
Install the rear end cover with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 4.6 N⋅m (47 kgf⋅cm, 41 in.⋅lbf)
A81164
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2920
19-49
STARTING & CHARGING
19.
SST (1-A)
SST (1-B)
-
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL GENERATOR PULLEY
SST 09820-63010 (09820-06010, 09820-06020)
HINT:
Hold
SST 1-A and B
09820-06010
SST 2
09820-06020
(a)
Turn
A92680
Install the pulley to the rotor shaft by tightening the generator pulley nut by hand.
(b) Hold SST (1-A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST
(1-B) clockwise with the specified torque.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Check that SST is secured to the rotor shaft.
(c)
(d)
Mount SST (2) in a vise.
Insert SST (1-A) and (B) into SST (2), and attach the generator pulley nut to SST (2).
(e)
Tighten the pulley nut by turning SST (1-A) in the direction shown in the illustration.
Torque: 111 N⋅m (1,125 kgf⋅cm, 81 ft⋅lbf)
Remove the generator from SST (2).
SST (2)
Insert
SST (1)
A81659
(f)
SST (1-A)
Turn
A81673
SST (1-A)
SST (1-B)
(g)
(h)
Turn SST (1-B), and remove SST (1-A), (B).
Turn the pulley, and check that the pulley moves smoothly.
Turn
Hold
A81661
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2921
19-40
STARTING & CHARGING
-
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
190O5-04
REPLACEMENT
(a)
(c)
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE GENERATOR ASSY
Remove the wire harness clamp.
Disconnect the generator connector.
Open the terminal cap, remove the nut and disconnect
the generator wire.
(d)
(e)
Loosen bolts A and B.
Loosen bolt C to lessen the tension of the V belt.
(f)
Remove bolts A and B, and the generator.
2.
(a)
INSTALL GENERATOR ASSY
Temporarily install the generator with bolts A and B.
(b)
A79746
A
B
C
A81657
A
B
A79747
A
B
A79747
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2912
19-41
STARTING & CHARGING
(b)
(c)
A
(d)
B
3.
C
(e)
(f)
INSPECT V BELT (See page 14-121 )
A81657
-
GENERATOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Adjust the V belt tension by tightening bolt C (see page
14-125 ).
Tighten bolts A and B.
Torque:
58 N⋅m (592 kgf⋅cm, 43 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
Install the generator wire with the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 7.0 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the generator connector.
Install the wire harness clamp.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2913
26-2
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
FRONT SUSPENSION SYSTEM
260DX-07
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
This is the repair procedure for vehicle pull.
START
*
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle pull?
Preliminary Check
Tire pressure
Vehicle height
Brake dragging
NO
Is the steering
off center?
NO
COMPLETE
YES
YES
Adjust front tie rods.
YES
Are the tires uni-directional type?
NO
NO
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still pull?
Cross switch front tire & wheel
assemblies (left & right).
YES
YES Does the vehicle pull in the
same direction as before?
NO
Choose the position of front tire & wheel
assemblies where there is least amount of pull.
Check front wheel alignment.
Is it within specification?
YES
NO Is the pull stronger
than before?
YES
NO
Reverse the front left side
tire and rebalance it.
Adjust front wheel alignment.
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still pull?
YES
NO
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still pull?
YES
Does the vehicle
pull to the left?
COMPLETE
YES
Increase right front camber and decrease
left front camber until pull is eliminated.
NO
NO
NO
NOTICE : Do not exceed 1° of cross camber.
Do not exceed adjustment range.
Increase left front camber and decrease
right front camber until pull is eliminated.
ROAD TEST
Does the vehicle still pull?
YES
Contact your local retail tire distributor.
*Select a flat road where the vehicle can be driven in a straight line for 100 meters at a constant speed
of 56km/h (35mph). Please confirm safety and set the steering wheel straight ahead. Drive the vehicle in
a straight line for 100 meters at a constant speed of 56km/h (35mph) without holding the steering wheel.
(1) The vehicle can keep straight but the steering wheel has some angle.
STEERING OFF CENTER (See page 50-4 )
(2) The vehicle cannot keep straight.
VEHICLE PULL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2923
26-1
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
FRONT SUSPENSION SYSTEM
FRONT SUSPENSION SYSTEM
260H6-04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority
of the possible cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
Symptom
Bottoming
Sways/pitches
Suspected Area
See page
1. Vehicle (Overloaded)
2. Spring (Weak)
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
26-12
26-12
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Stabilizer bar (Bent or broken)
28-1
26-22
26-25
26-12
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
1.
2.
3.
4.
Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
Wheel (Out of balance)
Shock absorber (Worn)
Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
5.
6.
7.
8.
Ball joint (Worn)
Hub bearing (Worn)
Steering linkage (Loose or worn)
Steering gear (Out of adjustment or broken)
Front wheel shimmy
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
4. Suspension parts (Worn)
28-1
26-7
27-5
26-12
-
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
26-2
26-2
26-2
26-2
26-2
Abnormal tire wear
Vehicle pull
28-1
28-1
26-12
26-7
27-5
26-20
30-3
51-3
Tire
Tire pressure (incorrect)
Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
Brake (Dragging)
Steering wheel (Off center)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2922
26-7
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
260H7-03
ADJUSTMENT
1.
INSPECT TIRE (SEE PAGE 26-7 )
2.
MEASURE VEHICLE HEIGHT
Vehicle height:
A
B
FF
C
4WD
DC
D
G31173
A
B
Front A - B
Rear D - C
FF
120.1 mm (4.73 in.)
40.5 mm (1.59 in.)
4WD
110.1 mm (4.33 in.)
30.5 mm (1.20 in.)
Measuring points:
A: Ground clearance of front wheel center
B: Ground clearance of lower suspension arm No.2 bush
set bolt center
C: Ground clearance of strut rod set bolt center
D: Ground clearance of rear wheel center
NOTICE:
Before inspecting the wheel alignment, adjust the vehicle
height to the specified value.
HINT:
Bounce the vehicle at the corners up and down to stabilize the
suspension and inspect the vehicle height.
3.
D
Front
INSPECT TOE-IN
Toe-in:
Toe-in
(total)
C
SA3213
If the toe-in is not within the specified range, adjust it at the rack
ends.
4.
ADJUST TOE-IN
(a) Remove the rack boot set clips.
(b) Loosen the tie rod end lock nuts.
(c)
G23792
A + B: 0° ± 10’ (0° ± 0.16°)
C - D: 0 ± 2 mm (0 ± 0.08 in.)
Turn the right and left rack ends by equal amounts to adjust the toe-in.
HINT:
Try to adjust the toe-in to the center of the specified value.
(d) Make sure that the lengths of the right and left rack ends
are the same.
Rack and length difference: 1.5 mm (0.059 in.) or less
(e) Torque the tie rod end lock nuts.
Torque: 74 N·m (755 kgf·cm, 55 ft·lbf)
(f)
Place the boots on the seats and install the clips.
HINT:
Make sure that the boots are not twisted.
(g) Perform VSC system calibration (see page 05-765 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2928
26-8
FRONT SUSPENSION
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
5.
(a)
INSPECT WHEEL ANGLE
Turn the steering wheel fully left and right to measure the
turning angle.
Wheel turning angle:
Front
A B
-
B A
Front
A: Inside
B: Outside
F46953
Inside wheel
Outside wheel:
Reference
FF
3528’ 2
(35.47 2)
3113’ (31.22)
4WD
3541’ 2
(35.68 2)
3122’ (31.37)
If the right and left inside wheel angles differ from the specified
value, check and adjust the right and left rack end lengths.
6.
INSPECT CAMBER, CASTER AND STEERING AXIS
INCLINATION
(a) Put the front wheel on the center of the alignment tester.
(b) Set the camber - caster - kingpin gauge at the center of
the axle hub or drive shaft.
Camber, caster and steering axis inclination:
Gauge
Alignment
Tester
FF
4WD
Right-left error
-0 °40’ ± 45’
(-0.67 ° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
-0 °35’ ± 45’
(-0.58 ° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
Right-left error
2°45’ ± 45’
(2.75° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
2°45’ ± 45’
(2.75° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
10°45’ ± 45’
(10.75° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
10°35’ ± 45’
(10.58° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
Camber
Z03382
Caster
Steering axis inclination
Right-left error
C83886
If the caster and steering axis inclination are not within the specified values after the camber has been correctly adjusted, recheck the suspension parts for damage and/or wear.
7.
ADJUST CAMBER
NOTICE:
Inspect toe-in after the camber has been adjusted.
(a) Remove the front wheel.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts on the lower side of the shock absorber.
HINT:
When removing the nuts, keep the bolts from rotating.
(c) Clean the installation surface of the shock absorber and
the steering knuckle.
(d) Temporarily install the 2 nuts.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2929
26-9
FRONT SUSPENSION
(e)
(f)
1
2
G32193
-
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Fully push or pull the front axle hub in the direction of the
required adjustment.
Tighten the nuts.
Torque: 230 N⋅m (2,350 kgf⋅cm, 170 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
When installing the nuts, keep the bolts from rotating and then
torque the nuts.
(g) Install the front wheel.
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Keep the bolts from rotating and torque the nuts.
(h) Install the front wheel.
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
(i)
Check the camber.
If the measured value is not within the specified range, calculate the required adjustment amount using the formula below.
(Camber adjustment amount) = Center of the specified range medium - Measured value
Check installed bolts combination. Select appropriate bolts
from the table below to adjust the camber to within the specified
range.
Move the axle toward (+) in step (e)
Refer to table (1) (Move the axle toward
positive side)
Move the axle toward (-) in step (e)
Refer to table (2) (Move the axle toward
negative side)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2930
26-10
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Table (1) (Move the axle toward positive side)
Installed
1
Bolt
Adjusting
2
Value
-1 30’ to -115’
No Dot
No Dot
No Dot
No Dot
1 Dot
2 Dots
3 Dots
No Dot
1 Dot
2 Dots
3 Dots
3 Dots
3 Dots
3 Dots
G
-1 15’ to -100’
G
A
G
A
B
G
A
B
C
G
A
B
C
D
G
A
B
C
D
E
F
-1 00’ to -045’
-0 45’ to -030’
-0 30’ to -015’
-0 15’ to 0
0 to 015’
A
B
C
D
E
015’ to 030
B
C
D
F
030’ to 045’
C
D
E
E
F
045’ to 100’
D
E
F
100’ to 115’
E
F
115’ to 130’
F
Selected Bolt Combination
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
90105-17012
90105-17012
90105-17012
90105-17013
90105-17014
90105-17015
90105-17012
90105-17013
90105-17014
90105-17015
90105-17015
90105-17015
90105-17015
90105-17012
1
2
Bolt Distinguishing Mark
No Dot
90105-17012
1 Dot
90105-17013
2 Dots
3 Dots
90105-17014
90105-17015
F47223
The body and suspension may be damaged if the camber is not
correctly adjusted according to the above table.
NOTICE:
Replace the nut with a new one when replacing the bolt.
(j)
Repeat the steps mentioned above. At step (b), replace
1 or 2 selected bolts.
HINT:
Replace one bolt at a time when replacing 2 bolts.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2931
26-1 1
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Table (2) (Move the axle toward negative side)
Installed
1
Bolt
Adjusting
2
Value
-1 30’ to -115’
No Dot
No Dot
No Dot
No Dot
1 Dot
2 Dots
3 Dots
No Dot
1 Dot
2 Dots
3 Dots
3 Dots
3 Dots
3 Dots
-1 15’ to -100’
E
F
-1 00’ to -045’
D
E
F
-0 45’ to -030’
C
D
E
F
-0 30’ to -015’
B
C
D
E
F
-0 15’ to 0
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
A
B
C
D
E
G
A
B
C
D
G
A
B
C
G
A
B
G
A
F
0 to 015’
015’ to 030
030’ to 045’
045’ to 100’
100’ to 115’
115’ to 130’
G
Selected Bolt Combination
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
90105-17012
90105-17012
90105-17012
90105-17013
90105-17014
90105-17015
90105-17012
90105-17013
90105-17014
90105-17015
90105-17015
90105-17015
90105-17015
90105-17012
1
2
Bolt Distinguishing Mark
No Dot
90105-17012
1 Dot
90105-17013
2 Dots
3 Dots
90105-17014
90105-17015
F47223
The body and suspension may be damaged if the camber is not
correctly adjusted according to the above table.
NOTICE:
Replace the nut with a new one when replacing the bolt.
(k) Repeat the steps mentioned above. At step (b), replace
1 or 2 selected bolts.
HINT:
Replace one bolt at a time when replacing 2 bolts.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2932
26-17
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT LH
260H9-02
DISPOSAL
HINT:
Dispose of the RH side by following the same procedures as with the LH side.
1.
(a)
(b)
DISPOSE OF SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT LH
Fully extend the shock absorber rod.
Using a drill, make a hole in the cylinder as shown in the
illustration to discharge the gas inside.
CAUTION:
Be careful when drilling because shards of metal may
fly about. Always use the proper safety equipment.
The gas is colorless, odorless and non-poisonous.
G29259
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2938
26-12
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT LH
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT LH
260H8-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
COMPONENTS: See page 26-3
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
(a)
SEPARATE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
Remove the nut and separate the front stabilizer link assy
LH from the shock absorber assy front LH.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (6 mm) to hold the stud.
C83858
G25726
3.
REMOVE FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL
SPRING
(a) Loosen the lock nut.
NOTICE:
Do not loosen or remove the lock nut except when
disassmbling the shock absorber assy front LH with
coil spring.
Do not remove the lock nut.
G29254
(b)
Remove the bolt and disconnect the front flexible hose
No. 1 and speed sensor front LH wire harness.
(c)
Remove the 2 nuts and bolts on the lower side of front
shock absorber with coil spring.
F40138
HINT:
When removing the bolts, keep the bolt from rotating and loosen the nut.
C83886
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2933
26-13
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT LH
(d)
Remove the 3 nuts on the upper side of the front shock
absorber with coil spring.
(e) Remove the front shock absorber with coil spring.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the front speed sensor is disconnected
from the front shock absorber.
G29255
4.
(a)
SST
SST
G29256
FIX FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
As shown in the illustration to the left, secure the front
shock absorber with coil spring in a vise by clamping onto
a double nutted bolt affixed to the bracket at the bottom
of the absorber.
F47185
5.
(a)
REMOVE SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT LH
Using SST, compress the front coil spring LH.
SST 09727-30021 (09727-00010, 09727-00021)
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage the SST.
HINT:
Use 2 of the same type of SST.
(b) Remove the front suspension support sub-assy LH, front suspension support bearing LH, front coil
spring seat upper LH, front coil spring insulator upper LH, front coil spring LH, front spring bumper LH
and front coil spring insulator lower LH from the shock absorber assy front LH.
6.
INSPECT SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT LH
(a) Compress and extend the shock absorber rod 4 times or
more.
Then check that there is no abnormal resistance or sound
and operation resistance is normal.
If there is any abnormality, replace the shock absorber assy
front LH with a new one.
NOTICE:
When disposing of the shock absorber assy front LH, see
G29257
DISPOSAL on page 26-17 .
7.
INSTALL SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT LH
(a) Install the front coil spring insulator lower LH onto the
shock absorber assy front LH.
(b) Install the front spring bumper LH to the piston rod.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2934
26-14
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT LH
(c)
SST
C83860
F47700
Using SST, compress the front coil spring LH.
SST 09727-30021 (09727-00010, 09727-00021)
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage the SST.
HINT:
Use 2 of the same type of SST.
(d) Install the front coil spring LH to the shock absorber assy
front LH.
HINT:
Fit the lower end of the front coil spring LH in the gap of the
spring lnsulator lower LH.
(e)
Install the front coil spring insulator upper LH with the
mark facing to the outside of the vehicle as shown in the
illustration.
(f)
Install the front coil spring seat upper LH to the shock absorber assy front LH with the mark facing to the outside
of the vehicle.
(g)
Install a new front suspension support bearing LH.
Outside
Outside
Mark
G25037
G25727
Outside
5
G25038
5
Mark
G25729
F40162
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2935
26-15
FRONT SUSPENSION
Outside
Outside
Mark
(h)
(i)
(j)
-
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT LH
Install the front suspension support sub-assy LH with the
mark facing to the outside of the vehicle.
Temporarily tighten a new lock nut.
Remove the SST slowly in order to release the coil spring.
SST 09727-30021 (09727-00010, 09727-00021)
G29258
8.
G29255
INSTALL FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL
SPRING
(a) Install the front shock absorber with coil spring .
(b) Install the 3 nuts to the upper side of front shock absorber
with coil spring.
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not tighten the lock nuts until installing the bolts and
nuts (lower side).
(c)
Install the 2 bolts and 2 nuts to the lower side of front
shock absorber with coil spring.
Torque: 230 N⋅m (2,350 kgf⋅cm, 170 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
When installing the nuts, keep the bolts from rotating and
torque the nut.
C83886
(d)
Install the front flexible hose No. 1 and speed sensor wire
harness front LH with the bolt.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
(e)
Fully tighten the lock nut.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
F40138
G29254
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2936
26-16
FRONT SUSPENSION
9.
(a)
-
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY FRONT LH
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
Install the front stabilizer link assy LH with the nut.
Torque: 74 N⋅m (755 kgf⋅cm, 55 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (6 mm) to hold the stud.
F40136
10.
11.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 26-7 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2937
26-20
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
LOWER BALL JOINT ASSY FRONT LH
LOWER BALL JOINT ASSY FRONT LH
260HB-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
COMPONENTS: See page 26-3 .
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST 09930-00010
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SEPARATE FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-38 )
REMOVE FRONT DISC
SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST 09628-6201 1
SEPARATE FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY LOWER NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
REMOVE FRONT AXLE ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-38 )
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE LOWER BALL JOINT ASSY FRONT LH
Remove the cotter pin and castle nut.
Using SST, remove the lower ball joint assy front LH.
SST 09628-6201 1
C95204
10.
(a)
INSPECT LOWER BALL JOINT ASSY FRONT LH
As shown in the illustration, flip the ball joint stud back and
forth 5 times.
(b) Using a torque wrench and nut, turn the ball joint continuously at a rate of 3 to 5 seconds per turn and take the
torque reading on the 5th turn.
Turning torque:
0.98 to 3.43 N·m (10 to 35 kgf·cm, 8.7 to 30 in.·lbf)
If
the
value
is not within the specification, replace the lower ball
ZX1712
joint assy front LH with a new one.
11. INSTALL LOWER BALL JOINT ASSY FRONT LH
(a) Install the lower ball joint assy front LH to the steering knuckle with the castle nut.
Torque: 123 N⋅m (1,250 kgf⋅cm, 91 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Prevent oil from adhering to the screw and tapered parts.
(b) Install a new cotter pin to the steering knuckle.
NOTICE:
If the holes for the cotter pin are not aligned, tighten the nut up to 60 further.
12. INSTALL FRONT AXLE ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-38 )
13. INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY LOWER NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2941
26-21
FRONT SUSPENSION
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
-
LOWER BALL JOINT ASSY FRONT LH
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT DISC
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-38 )
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 26-7 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2942
26-3
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
FRONT SUSPENSION
FRONT SUSPENSION
260DY-05
COMPONENTS
80 (816, 59)
49 (500, 36)
Front Suspension Support
Sub-assy LH
Front Stabilizer
Link Assy LH
Front Suspension Support
Bearing LH
74 (755, 55)
Front Coil Spring Seat Upper LH
Front Shock Absorber
w/ Coil Spring
Front Coil Spring Insulator
Upper LH
Front Spring
Bumper LH
230 (2,350, 170)
Speed Sensor
front LH
Front Coil Spring
Insulator Lower LH
19 (194, 14)
Front Flexible
Hose No.1
Front Coil Spring LH
Shock Absorber Assy Front LH
Front Axle Assy LH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
G29262
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2924
26-4
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
FRONT SUSPENSION
Tie Rod Assy LH
74 (755, 55)
Speed Sensor Front LH
Front Stabilizer Link Assy LH
230 (2,350, 170)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
104 (1,060, 77)
123 (1,250, 91)
Front Disc
Cotter Pin
104 (1,060, 77)
Front Brake
Caliper Assy
Front Axle Assy LH
294 (3,000, 217)
Front Suspension Member
Dynamic Damper
Transverse Engine
Engine Mounting
Insulator
3MZ-FE:
29 (296, 21)
49 (500, 36)
Cotter Pin
200 (2,040, 148)
200 (2,040, 148)
Lower Ball Joint
Assy Front LH
Front Lower Arm
Bush Stopper
Front Frame Assy
87 (887, 64)
206 (2,100, 152)
127 (1,300, 94)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Front Suspension Arm
Sub-assy Lower No.1 LH
G32192
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2925
26-5
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
FRONT SUSPENSION
FF:
16 (163, 12)
Front Stabilizer Bracket No.1 RH
74 (755, 55)
Front Stabilizer
Bar Bush No.1
16 (163, 12)
Front Stabilizer
Link Assy RH
Front Stabilizer Bracket No.1 LH
Stabilizer Bar Front
Front Stabilizer Bar Bush No.1
Front Stabilizer Link Assy
74 (755, 55)
74 (755, 55)
230 (2,350, 170)
70 (715, 52)
Power Steering
Link Assy
Front Stabilizer
Bracket No.2 RH
Front Stabilizer
Bracket No.2 LH
49 (500, 36)
Cotter Pin
Front Frame Assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
F45482
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2926
26-6
FRONT SUSPENSION
4WD:
3MZ-FE
Exhaust Manifold
Heat Insulator
No.1
-
FRONT SUSPENSION
8.5 (87, 75 in.⋅lbf)
Exhaust Pipe
Sub-assy Front No.3
Gasket
49 (500, 36)
56 (571, 41)
Exhaust Manifold
Converter Sub-assy
Gasket
Manifold Stay
56 (571, 41)
34 (347, 25)
48 (489, 35)
34 (347, 25)
16 (163, 12)
16 (163, 12)
Front Stabilizer Bracket No.1 LH
Front Stabilizer Bracket No.1 RH
Front Stabilizer
Bar Bush No.1
Front Stabilizer
Link Assy RH
Front Stabilizer Bar
Bush No.1
Stabilizer
Bar Front
Front Stabilizer Link Assy LH
74 (755, 55)
Front Stabilizer
Bracket No.2 RH
70 (715, 52)
74 (755, 55)
74 (755, 55)
Power Steering
Link Assy
230 (2,350, 170)
Front Stabilizer
Bracket No.2 LH
70 (715, 52)
Front Frame Assy
49 (500, 36)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Cotter Pin
F45483
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2927
26-18
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY LOWER NO.1
LH
FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY LOWER NO.1 LH
260HA-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
COMPONENTS: See page 26-3 .
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 14-149 )
REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 14-24 )
3.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSVERSE ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR
Remove the 3 nuts and the transverse engine mounting
insulator.
C83387
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB- ASSY
LOWER NO.1 LH
Remove the 3 bolts and the nut on the suspension arm
lower No.1 LH and remove it from the front frame assy.
Remove the front lower arm bush stopper.
C65934
5.
1
2
(a)
(b)
3
C65934
C66233
(c)
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB- ASSY
LOWER NO.1 LH
Install the front lower arm bush stopper.
Install the suspension arm lower No.1 LH to the front
frame assy with the 3 bolts and the nut.
Tighten the 3 bolts in numerical order as shown in the illustration.
Torque:
(bolt 1, 2) 200 N⋅m (2,040 kgf⋅cm, 148 ft⋅lbf)
(bolt 3) 206 N⋅m (2,100 kgf⋅cm, 152 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Start tightening the bolts from the front side of the vehicle.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2939
FRONT SUSPENSION
6.
(a)
-
FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY LOWER NO.1
LH
26-19
INSTALL TRANSVERSE ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR
Install the transverse engine mounting insulator with the
3 nuts.
Torque: 87 N⋅m (887 kgf⋅cm, 64 ft⋅lbf)
C83387
7.
8.
INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2940
26-25
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
STABILIZER BAR FRONT (4WD)
STABILIZER BAR FRONT (4WD)
260HD-04
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
COMPONENTS: See page 28-1 .
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and the front stabilizer link assy LH.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (6 mm) to hold the stud.
F40143
3.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side following the same procedures as with the LH side.
4.
(a)
5.
INSPECT FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
As shown in the illustration, flip the ball joint stud back and
forth 5 times.
(b) Using a torque wrench and nut, turn the nut continuously
at a rate of 2 to 4 seconds per turn and take the torque
reading on the 5th turn.
Turning torque:
0.05 to 1.96 N·m (0.5 to 20 kgf·cm, 0.4 to 17.4 in.·lbf)
If
the
value
is not within the specification, replace the front stabiC66721
lizer link assy LH with a new one.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE SUB-ASSY FRONT NO.3 (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 15-5 )
6.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.1 LH
Remove the 2 bolts and front stabilizer bracket No.1 LH.
F40144
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2946
26-26
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
STABILIZER BAR FRONT (4WD)
7.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.1 RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side following the same procedures as with the LH side.
8.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.2 LH
(a) Remove the front stabilizer bracket No.2 LH from the stabilizer bar bush.
9.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.2 RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side following the same procedures with the LH side.
10. SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST 09628-6201 1
11. SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY RH
SST 09628-6201 1
HINT:
Separate the RH side following the same procedures as with the LH side.
12. SEPARATE STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
13. DISCONNECT RETURN TUBE ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
SST 09023-12701
14. DISCONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
SST 09023-12701
15. REMOVE POWER STEERING LINK ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
16. REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BAR BUSH NO.1
(a) Remove the 2 bushes from the stabilizer.
17. REMOVE MANIFOLD STAY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
18. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD HEAT INSULATOR NO.1 (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 15-5 )
19. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 15-5 )
20. REMOVE STABILIZER BAR FRONT
(a) Remove the stabilizer bar front from the vehicle.
21. INSTALL STABILIZER BAR FRONT
(a) Install the stabilizer bar front from the vehicle.
22. INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD CONVERTER SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 15-5 )
23. INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD HEAT INSULATOR NO.1 (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 15-5 )
24. INSTALL MANIFOLD STAY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
Outer side
Cutout
Rear
side
25. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BAR BUSH NO.1
HINT:
Install the bushing to the outer side of the bush stopper
on the stabilizer bar.
Place the cutout of the stabilizer bush facing the rear side
as shown in the illustration.
Bush stopper
G31174
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2947
26-27
FRONT SUSPENSION
26.
27.
28.
-
STABILIZER BAR FRONT (4WD)
INSTALL POWER STEERING LINK ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
INSTALL PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
SST 09023-12701
INSTALL RETURN TUBE ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
SST 09023-12701
CONNECT STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY RH
29.
30.
31.
HINT:
Install the RH side following the same procedures as with the LH side.
32. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.2 LH
(a) Install the front stabilizer bracket No. 2 to the stabilizer bar bush No.1.
33. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.2 RH
HINT:
Install the RH side following the same procedures as with the LH side.
34. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.1 LH
(a) Install the front stabilizer bracket No. 1 LH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 16 N⋅m (163 kgf⋅cm, 12 ft⋅lbf)
F40144
35. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.1 RH
HINT:
Install the RH side following the same procedures as with the LH side.
36. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE SUB-ASSY FRONT NO.3 (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 15-5 )
37. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
(a) Install the front stabilizer link assy LH with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 74 N⋅m (755 kgf⋅cm, 55 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (6 mm) to hold the stud.
F40143
38. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Install the RH side following the same procedures as with the LH side.
39. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
40. BLEED POWER STEERING FLUID (SEE PAGE 51-3 )
41. CHECK POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKAGE
42. INSPECT AND ADJUST STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
43. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 26-7 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2948
26-22
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
STABILIZER BAR FRONT (FF)
STABILIZER BAR FRONT (FF)
260HC-04
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
COMPONENTS: See page 26-3 .
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and the front stabilizer link assy LH.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (6 mm) to hold the stud.
F40143
3.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side by following the same procedures as with the LH side.
4.
(a)
C66721
INSPECT FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
As shown in the illustration, flip the ball joint stud back and
forth 5 times .
(b) Using a torque wrench and nut, turn the nut continuously
at a rate of 2 to 4 seconds per turn and take the torque
reading on the 5th turn.
Turning torque:
0.05 to 1.96 N·m (0.5 to 20 kgf·cm, 0.4 to 17.4 in.·lbf)
If the value is not within the specification, replace the front stabilizer link assy LH with a new one.
5.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.1 LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and the front stabilizer bracket No. 1
LH.
F40144
6.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.1 RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side by following the same procedures as with the LH side.
7.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.2 LH
(a) Remove the front stabilizer bracket No. 2 LH from the stabilizer bar bush.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2943
26-23
FRONT SUSPENSION
-
STABILIZER BAR FRONT (FF)
8.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.2 RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side following the same procedures as with as the LH side.
9.
DISCONNECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST 09628-6201 1
10. DISCONNECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY RH
SST 09628-6201 1
HINT:
Disconnect the RH side following the same procedures as with the LH side.
11. SEPARATE STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
12. DISCONNECT STEERING GEAR OUTLET RETURN TUBE (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
SST 09023-12701
13. DISCONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
SST 09023-12701
14. REMOVE POWER STEERING LINK ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
15. REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BAR BUSH NO.1
(a) Remove the 2 bushes from the stabilizer.
16. REMOVE STABILIZER BAR FRONT
(a) Remove the stabilizer bar front from the vehicle.
17. INSTALL STABILIZER BAR FRONT
(a) Install the stabilizer bar front to the vehicle.
Outer side
Cutout
Rear
side
18. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BAR BUSH NO.1
HINT:
Install the bush to the outer side of the bush stopper on
the stabilizer bar.
Place the cutout of the stabilizer bush facing the rear side
as shown in the illustration.
Bush stopper
G31174
19.
20.
21.
INSTALL POWER STEERING LINK ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
INSTALL PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
SST 09023-12701
INSTALL STEERING GEAR OUTLET RETURN TUBE (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
SST 09023-12701
CONNECT STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 51-28 )
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY RH
22.
23.
24.
HINT:
Install the RH side following the same procedures as with the LH side.
25. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.2 LH
(a) Install the front stabilizer bracket No. 2 to the stabilizer bar bush No.1.
26. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.2 RH
HINT:
Install the RH side following the same procedure as with the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2944
26-24
FRONT SUSPENSION
27.
(a)
-
STABILIZER BAR FRONT (FF)
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.1 LH
Install the front stabilizer bracket No. 1 LH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 16 N⋅m (163 kgf⋅cm, 12 ft⋅lbf)
F40144
28. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.1 RH
HINT:
Install the RH side following the same procedures as with the LH side.
29.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
Install the front stabilizer link assy LH with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 74 N⋅m (755 kgf⋅cm, 55 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (6 mm) to hold the stud.
F40143
30. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Install the RH side following the same procedures as with the LH side.
31. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
32. BLEED POWER STEERING FLUID (SEE PAGE 51-3 )
33. CHECK POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKAGE
34. INSPECT AND ADJUST STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
35. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 26-7 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2945
27-1
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
REAR SUSPENSION SYSTEM
2701I-11
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below, with suspected areas listed in numerical order, to determine the cause of the problem.
Inspect and repair or replace parts as necessary according to the steps on the following pages.
Symptom
Bottoming
Sways/pitches
Suspected Area
See page
1. Vehicle (Overloaded)
2. Spring (Weak)
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
27-7
27-7
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Stabilizer bar (Bent or broken)
28-1
27-27
27-29
27-7
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
Rear wheel shimmy
1.
2.
3.
4.
Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
Wheel (Out of balance)
Shock absorber (Worn)
Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
28-1
28-1
27-7
26-7
27-5
30-3
5. Hub bearing (Worn)
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
28-1
26-7
27-5
27-7
-
Abnormal tire wear
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
4. Suspension parts (Worn)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2949
27-5
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
2701J-06
ADJUSTMENT
1.
INSPECT TIRE (SEE PAGE 28-1 )
2.
MEASURE VEHICLE HEIGHT (SEE PAGE 26-7 )
NOTICE:
Before inspecting wheel alignment, adjust the vehicle height to the specified value.
A
B
3.
D
INSPECT TOE-IN
A + B: 0°18’ ± 12’ (0.3° ± 0.2°)
C - D: 3 ± 2 mm (0.12 ± 0.08 in.)
Toe-in
(total)
Front
HINT:
Measure ”C - D” only when ”A + B” cannot be measured.
If the toe-in is not within the specified range, inspect the
suspension parts and replace them if necessary.
C
SA3213
4.
(a)
ADJUST TOE-IN (FF DRIVE TYPE)
Measure the lengths of the right and left No.2 lower suspension arms.
No. 2 lower suspension arm length difference:
1.5 mm (0.06 in.) or less
If the left-right difference is larger than 1.5 mm (0.06 in.), adjust
it by following the procedures below.
C83001
(b)
(c)
Loosen the 2 lock nuts.
Turn the right and left adjusting tubes by an equal amount
to adjust toe-in.
HINT:
(d)
C83002
Try to adjust the toe-in to the center value.
One turn of each adjusting tube will adjust toe-in by
approximately 1.1 (111’), 11.1mm (0.437 in.).
Torque the 2 lock nuts.
Torque: 56 N⋅m (570 kgf⋅cm, 41 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2953
27-6
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
5.
(a)
ADJUST TOE-IN (4WD DRIVE TYPE)
Measure the distance between each wheel disc and corner of the toe-adjusting cam, and then confirm that left
and right distances are the same.
No. 2 lower suspension arm length difference:
1.0 mm (0.04 in.) or less
If the left-right difference is larger than 1.0 mm (0.04 in.), adjust
it by following the procedures below.
(b) Turn the adjust cams by an equal amount to adjust toe-in.
HINT:
Try to adjust the toe-in to the center value.
The toe-in will change by the following specifications corresponding to each graduation of the cam.
Approx. 3.3 mm (0.13 in.)
(c) Tighten the nut.
Torque: 100 N⋅m (1,020 kgf⋅cm, 74 ft⋅lbf)
G25768
G25056
6.
INSPECT CAMBER
Camber
Right-left error
FF
4WD
-1 °20’ ± 45’ (-1.33° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
-0 °45’ ± 45’ (-0.75° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
HINT:
Camber is not adjustable. If the measurement is not within the specification, inspect the suspension parts
for damage and/or wear, and replace them if necessary.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2954
27-16
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (FF)
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (FF)
270HY-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 27-2 .
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE STABILIZER BAR REAR (SEE PAGE 27-27 )
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH
Support the rear axle carrier with a jack.
Remove the bolt and disconnect the rear suspension arm
assy No.1 (inner side).
C82994
(c)
Remove the bolt, nut and the rear suspension arm assy
No.1 (outer side) from the rear axle carrier.
NOTICE:
When removing the bolt, keep the nut from rotating.
C83800
G26318
4.
(a)
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM
ASSY NO.1 LH
Install the rear suspension arm assy No.1 (inner side) with
the bolt, and temporarily tighten the bolt.
C82994
Rear
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
Paint Mark
B53748
HINT:
Ensure that the paint mark on the rear suspension arm assy
No.1 faces the rear side of the vehicle.
B73546
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2964
27-17
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (FF)
(b)
Connect the rear suspension arm assy No.1 (outer side)
to the rear axle carrier with the bolt and nut and temporarily tighten the bolt and nut.
NOTICE:
When installing the bolt, fix the nut and temporarily tighten
the bolt.
C83800
5.
G26318
STABILIZE SUSPENSION (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
6.
(a)
FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY
NO.1 LH
Fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 120 N⋅m (1,220 kgf⋅cm, 89 ft⋅lbf)
C82994
(b)
C82996
7.
8.
9.
Fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 112 N⋅m (1,140 kgf⋅cm, 83 ft⋅lbf)
G26319
INSTALL STABILIZER BAR REAR (SEE PAGE 27-27 )
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2965
27-25
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (4WD)
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (4WD)
270I1-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 27-2 .
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
(a)
(b)
Matchmarks
G25057
REMOVE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH
Support the rear axle carrier with a jack.
Place matchmarks on the adjust cams and rear suspension member sub-assy.
(c) Remove the nut, camber adjust cam and toe adjust cam,
and disconnect the rear suspension arm assy No.2 (inner
side).
NOTICE:
When removing the nut, keep the bolt from rotating.
(d)
Remove the bolt, nut and the rear suspension arm assy
No.2 (outer side) from the rear axle carrier.
NOTICE:
When removing the bolt, keep the nut from rotating.
F46331
3.
Matchmarks
(a)
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM
ASSY NO.2 LH
Install the rear suspension arm No.2 (inner side) to the
rear suspension member sub-assy with the camber adjust cam and toe adjust cam, and temporarily tighten the
nut.
G25057
Rear
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
Paint Mark
HINT:
Ensure that the paint mark on the rear suspension arm assy
No.2 faces to the rear side of the vehicle.
B53748
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2973
27-26
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (4WD)
(b)
Connect the rear suspension arm assy No.2 (outer side)
to the rear axle carrier with the bolt and nut.
NOTICE:
When installing the bolt, fix the nut and temporarily tighten
the bolt.
F46331
4.
STABILIZE SUSPENSION (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
5.
Matchmarks
(a)
(b)
FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY
NO.2 LH
Align the matchmarks on the adjust cams and rear suspension member sub-assy.
Fully tighten the nut.
Torque: 100 N⋅m (1,020 kgf⋅cm, 74 ft⋅lbf)
G25057
(c)
Fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 112 N⋅m (1,140 kgf⋅cm, 83 ft⋅lbf)
F46330
6.
7.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2974
27-27
REAR SUSPENSION
-
STABILIZER BAR REAR (FF)
STABILIZER BAR REAR (FF)
270EI-04
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 27-2 .
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and stabilizer link.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (5 mm) to hold the stud.
C82629
3.
REMOVE REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
4.
(a)
C66721
INSPECT REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
As shown in the illustration, flip the ball joint stud back and
forth 5 times.
(b) Using a torque wrench and nut, turn the ball joint continuously at a rate of 3 to 5 seconds per turn and take the
torque reading on the 5th turn.
Turning torque:
1.0 N·m (10 kgf·cm, 9 in.·lbf) or less
If the value is not within the specification, replace the rear stabilizer link assy with a new one.
NOTICE:
Check that neither unusual drag nor rattle occurs during the rotation.
Check that neither cracks nor grease leakage exists
on the dust cover.
5.
REMOVE REAR STABILIZER BAR BRACKET NO.1
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and stabilizer bar bracket.
C82630
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2975
27-28
REAR SUSPENSION
6.
(a)
-
STABILIZER BAR REAR (FF)
REMOVE STABILIZER BAR REAR
Remove the stabilizer bar and 2 stabilizer bush.
7.
(a)
Outer Side
(b)
INSTALL STABILIZER BAR REAR
Install the stabilizer bush to the outer side of the stopper
ring on the stabilizer bar.
Install the stabilizer bar.
Rear
Side
Stopper Ring
F47188
8.
(a)
INSTALL REAR STABILIZER BAR BRACKET NO.1
Install the stabilizer bar bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
9.
(a)
INSTALL REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
Install the stabilizer link with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
C82630
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (5 mm) to hold the stud.
C82629
10. INSTALL REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Install the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
11. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
12. INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2976
27-29
REAR SUSPENSION
-
STABILIZER BAR REAR (4WD)
STABILIZER BAR REAR (4WD)
270EJ-03
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 27-2 .
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and stabilizer link.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (5 mm) to hold the stud.
C82631
3.
REMOVE REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
4.
(a)
C66721
INSPECT REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
As shown in the illustration, flip the ball joint stud back and
forth 5 times.
(b) Using a torque wrench and nut, turn the ball joint continuously at a rate of 3 to 5 seconds per turn and take the
torque reading on the 5th turn.
Turning torque:
1.0 N·m (10 kgf·cm, 9 in.·lbf) or less
If the value is not within the specification, replace the rear stabilizer link assy with a new one.
NOTICE:
Check that neither unusual drag nor rattle occurs during the rotation.
Check that neither cracks nor grease leakage exists
on the dust cover.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2977
27-30
REAR SUSPENSION
Left side:
-
STABILIZER BAR REAR (4WD)
5.
(a)
REMOVE STABILIZER BAR REAR
Remove the 3 bolts and stabilizer bar.
6.
(a)
INSTALL STABILIZER BAR REAR
Install the stabilizer bracket.
(b)
Install the stabilizer bar with the 3 bolts.
Torque:
Bolt A: 54 N⋅m (550 kgf⋅cm, 40 ft⋅lbf)
Bolt B: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
G25065
Right side:
F45738
Left side:
G25072
G25990
Left side:
(A)
G25065
Right side:
(B)
(B)
F45738
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2978
27-31
REAR SUSPENSION
7.
(a)
-
STABILIZER BAR REAR (4WD)
INSTALL REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
Install the stabilizer link with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (5 mm) to hold the stud.
C82631
8.
INSTALL REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Install the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
9.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
10. INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2979
27-12
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
2701L-11
DISPOSAL
1.
(a)
(b)
A
B
F45737
DISPOSE OF SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY REAR LH
Fully extend the shock absorber rod.
Using a drill, make a hole in the cylinder somewhere between A and B as shown in the illustration to discharge the
gas inside.
CAUTION:
Be careful when drilling as shards of metal may fly
about. Always use the proper safety equipment.
The gas is colorless, odorless and non-poisonous.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2960
27-7
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
270HX-01
OVERHAUL
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 27-2 .
1.
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM COVER LH
2.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
3.
(a)
SEPARATE REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
Support the rear axle carrier with a jack.
(b)
Remove the nut and disconnect the stabilizer link from the
shock absorber.
F46326
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (5 mm) to hold the stud.
C83156
4.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL
SPRING
FF:
Disconnect the skid control sensor connector. Remove
the 2 bolts, and disconnect the flexible hose and skid control sensor wire from the shock absorber.
G25060
(b)
4WD:
Remove the 3 bolts, and disconnect the flexible hose and
speed sensor from the shock absorber and rear axle carrier.
G25070
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2955
27-8
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
(c) Loosen the 2 nuts on the lower side of the shock absorber.
HINT:
Do not remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
C83160
G25778
(d)
(e)
(f)
Remove the 3 nuts.
Lower the rear axle carrier, and remove the 2 nuts and 2
bolts on the lower side of the shock absorber.
Remove the shock absorber with coil spring.
G28842
5.
(a)
28 mm
(1.1 in.)
FIX REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
Install the 2 nuts and bolt to the bracket at the lower part
of the shock absorber, and secure it in a vise as shown in
the illustration to the left.
G25796
6.
(a)
REMOVE SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY REAR LH
Loosen the nut while holding the LH support suspension
with a bar taped up so as not to damage the stud bolts.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the LH support suspension stud bolts.
Do not remove the nut.
G28844
(b)
Using SST, compress the coil spring.
SST 09727- 30021 (09727- 00010, 09727- 00021,
09727-00031)
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage the SST.
(c) Remove the nut, collar and LH support suspension.
(d) Remove the coil spring, spring bumper and insulator lower.
SST
F45723
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2956
27-9
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
7.
(a)
INSPECT SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY REAR LH
Compress and extend the shock absorber rod, and check
that there is no abnormal resistance or unusual sound.
If there is any abnormality, replace the shock absorber with a
new one.
NOTICE:
When disposing of the shock absorber, see DISPOSAL on
page 27-12 .
G28843
8.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SHOCK ABSORBER ASSY REAR LH
Install the spring bumper.
Install the insulator lower, as shown in the illustration.
G26304
(c)
SST
F41029
Using SST, compress the coil spring.
SST 09727- 30021 (09727- 00010, 09727- 00021,
09727-00031)
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage the SST.
(d) Install the coil spring to the shock absorber.
HINT:
Fit the lower end of the coil spring into the gap of the insulator
lower.
Lower Bracket
(e)
3.5 5
HINT:
Ensure that the stud bolt is positioned 3.5 to the front of the
vehicle as shown in the illustration, and the deviation should be
within 5.
Front
Outside
LH Support Suspension
Align the LH support suspension with the shock absorber
lower bracket, as shown in the illustration.
F45739
SST
(f)
Install the collar to the piston rod.
(g) Temporarily install a new nut.
(h) Remove the SST.
HINT:
After removing SST, recheck the direction of the LH support
suspension.
F02773
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2957
27-10
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
(i)
Fully tighten the nut while holding the LH support suspension with a bar taped up so as not to damage the stud
bolts.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not damage the LH support suspension stud bolts.
G28844
9.
(a)
INSTALL REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL
SPRING
Install the shock absorber with coil spring and tighten the
3 nuts.
Torque: 58 N⋅m (590 kgf⋅cm, 43 ft⋅lbf)
G28842
(b)
Install the 2 bolts and nuts to the shock absorber with coil
spring.
Torque: 180 N⋅m (1,840 kgf⋅cm, 133 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
When installing the nut, keep the bolt from rotating.
C83160
G25778
(A)
(c)
FF:
Install the flexible hose and skid control sensor wire with
the 2 bolts. Connect the skid control sensor connector.
Torque:
Bolt A: 19 N⋅m (192 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
Bolt B: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
(d)
4WD:
Install the flexible hose and speed sensor with the 3 bolts.
Torque:
Bolt A: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
Bolt B: 19 N⋅m (192 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
Bolt C: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
(B)
G25060
(A)
(B)
(C)
G25070
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2958
27-1 1
REAR SUSPENSION
10.
(a)
-
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
INSTALL REAR STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
Install the stabilizer link to the shock absorber with the nut.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (5 mm) to hold the stud.
C83156
11.
12.
13.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2959
27-13
REAR SUSPENSION
-
STRUT ROD ASSY REAR
STRUT ROD ASSY REAR
270EE-03
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 27-2 .
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
(a)
REMOVE STRUT ROD ASSY REAR
Support the rear axle carrier with a jack.
(b)
Remove the bolt and nut, and separate the parking brake
cable.
F46326
G25061
(c)
Remove the bolt and nut, and disconnect the strut rod
(front side).
NOTICE:
When removing the bolt, keep the nut from rotating.
G25062
(d)
Remove the bolt, nut and strut rod from the rear axle carrier.
NOTICE:
When removing the bolt, keep the nut from rotating.
F46324
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2961
27-14
REAR SUSPENSION
-
STRUT ROD ASSY REAR
3.
(a)
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR
Install the strut rod (rear side), bolt and nut, and temporarily tighten the bolt.
NOTICE:
When installing the bolt, fix the nut and temporarily tighten
the bolt.
F46325
(b)
Support the rear axle carrier.
F46326
(c) Connect the strut rod (front side) with the bolt and nut.
NOTICE:
When installing the bolt, fix the nut and temporarily tighten
the bolt.
G25062
4.
(a)
STABILIZE SUSPENSION
FF:
Jack up the rear axle carrier, placing a wood block to avoid
damage. Apply load to the suspension so that the
installed bolt of the suspension arm assy No.1 (inner side
of the vehicle) is horizontally aligned with the center of the
rear axle hub.
(b)
4WD:
Jack up the rear axle carrier, placing a wood block to avoid
damage. Apply load to the suspension so that the rear
drive shaft assy is horizontally positioned.
G25792
G25793
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2962
27-15
REAR SUSPENSION
-
STRUT ROD ASSY REAR
5.
(a)
FULLY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR
Fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
(b)
Fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
(c)
Install the parking brake cable with the bolt and nut.
Torque:
Bolt: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
Nut: 6.0 N⋅m (61 kgf⋅cm, 53 in.⋅lbf)
F46324
G25062
G25061
6.
7.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2963
27-18
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (4WD)
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (4WD)
270HZ-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 27-2 .
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY
(a) 2AZ-FE (see page 15-2 )
(b) 3MZ-FE (see page 15-5 )
3.
REMOVE PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (SEE PAGE 30-12 )
SST 09325-20010
4.
REMOVE STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
5.
(a)
SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH
Remove the bolt, nut and the rear suspension arm assy
No.2 (outer side) from the rear axle carrier.
NOTICE:
When removing the bolt, keep the nut from rotating.
F46327
6.
SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 RH
HINT:
Separate the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
7.
(a)
SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH
Remove the bolt, nut and the rear suspension arm assy
No.1 (outer side) from the rear axle carrier.
NOTICE:
When removing the bolt, keep the nut from rotating.
F46328
8.
SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 RH
HINT:
Separate the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
9.
REMOVE SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
10. REMOVE SPEED SENSOR REAR RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
11. REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2966
27-19
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (4WD)
12. REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
C82990
REMOVE REAR SUSPENSION MEMBER SUB-ASSY
Support the rear suspension member with a jack.
Remove the 4 nuts, 2 bolts and 2 retainers from the rear
suspension member.
Lower the rear suspension member.
G25770
14. REMOVE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH
(a) Remove the bolt, nut and rear suspension arm assy No.1.
NOTICE:
When removing the bolt, keep the nut from rotating.
C82991
15.
(a)
INSTALL REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH
Install the rear suspension arm assy No.1 with the bolt
and nut, and temporarily tighten the bolt.
C82991
HINT:
Ensure that the paint mark on the rear suspension arm assy
No.1 faces the rear side of the vehicle.
Rear
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
Paint Mark
B53748
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2967
27-20
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (4WD)
(b)
Set the rear suspension arm assy No.1 in the position
shown in the illustration, and fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
16.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL REAR SUSPENSION MEMBER SUB-ASSY
Raise the rear suspension member with a jack.
Install the rear suspension member with the 4 nuts, 2 bolts
and 2 retainers.
Torque:
Front side: 115 N⋅m (1,170 kgf⋅cm, 85 ft⋅lbf)
Rear side: 181 N⋅m (1,850 kgf⋅cm, 134 ft⋅lbf)
30 mm
(1.18 in.)
G25794
C82990
G25770
17. INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
18. INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH
HINT:
Install the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
19. INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
20. INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR RH
HINT:
Install the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
21.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM
ASSY NO.1 LH
(a) Install the rear suspension arm assy No.1 (outer side) to
the rear axle carrier, and temporarily tighten the bolt.
NOTICE:
When installing the bolt, fix the nut and temporarily tighten
the bolt.
F46328
22. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 RH
HINT:
Temporarily tighten the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2968
27-21
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (4WD)
23.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM
ASSY NO.2 LH
(a) Install the rear suspension arm No. 2 (outer side) to the
rear axle carrier, and temporarily tighten the bolt.
NOTICE:
When installing the bolt, fix the nut and temporarily tighten
the bolt.
F46327
24. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 RH
HINT:
Temporarily tighten the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
25. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
26. STABILIZE SUSPENSION (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
27. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY
NO.1 LH
(a) Fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 112 N⋅m (1,140 kgf⋅cm, 83 ft⋅lbf)
F46329
28. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 RH
HINT:
Fully tighten the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
29.
(a)
FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY
NO.2 LH
Fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 112 N⋅m (1,140 kgf⋅cm, 83 ft⋅lbf)
F46330
30. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 RH
HINT:
Fully tighten the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
31. FULLY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
32. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
33. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY
(SEE PAGE 30-12 )
34. FULLY TIGHTEN PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (SEE PAGE 30-12 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2969
27-22
REAR SUSPENSION
35.
(a)
(b)
36.
37.
38.
-
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (4WD)
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY
2AZ-FE (see page 15-2 )
3MZ-FE (see page 15-5 )
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2970
27-2
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION
REAR SUSPENSION
270EB-03
COMPONENTS
FF:
49 (500, 36)
x3
58 (590, 43)
Rear Support
To Rear Shock
Absorber LH
Collar
Rear Suspension Member Sub-assy
LH Support Assy Rear Suspension
Rear Spring Bumper No.1 LH
Rear Stabilizer Link Assy LH
Stabilizer Bush Stabilizer Bar
Rear
Rear
Coil Spring
Rear LH
39 (400, 29)
120 (1,220, 89)
Rear Coil
Spring Insulator
Lower LH
Rear Stabilizer
Bar Bracket
No.1
56 (570, 41)
19 (194, 14)
Shock Absorber
Assy Rear LH
Rear Suspension
Arm Assy No.2 LH
Rear Suspension Arm
Assy No.1 LH
39 (400, 29)
112 (1,140, 83)
19 (192, 14)
120 (1,220, 89)
Flexible Hose
180 (1,840, 133)
112 (1,140, 83)
Skid Control
Sensor Wire
80 (816, 59)
80 (816, 59)
5.0 (51, 44 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.3
Strut Rod Assy Rear
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
39 (400, 29)
F45734
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2950
27-3
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION
4WD:
Rear Suspension Member Sub-assy
49 (500, 36)
x3
58 (590, 43)
LH Support Assy Rear Suspension
Rear Support
To Rear shock
Absorber LH
Collar
181 (1,850, 134)
Rear Spring Bumper No.1 LH
Retainer
Retainer
Coil Spring
Rear LH
Rear Coil Spring Insulator Lower LH
115 (1,170, 85)
Rear Suspension Toe
Adjust Cam Sub-assy
Camber Adjust
Cam No.2
100 (1,020, 74)
Shock Absorber
Assy Rear LH
Rear Suspension
Arm Assy No.2 LH
Rear Suspension
Arm Assy No.1 LH
5.0 (51, 44in.⋅lbf)
112 (1,140, 83)
80 (816, 59)
180 (1,840, 133)
112 (1,140, 83)
Flexible
Hose
Speed Sensor
Rear LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
80 (816, 59)
80 (816, 59)
19 (192, 14)
294 (3,000, 217)
Strut Rod Assy Rear
Parking Brake Cable
Assy No.3
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
39 (400, 29)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
F45735
F47189
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2951
27-4
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION
4WD:
Rear Stabilizer
Link Assy RH
Stabilizer Bar Rear
39 (400, 29)
Rear Stabilizer Link Assy LH
x2
19 (194, 14)
39 (400, 29)
54 (550, 40)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
: Specified torque
G25082
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2952
27-23
REAR SUSPENSION
-
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (FF)
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (FF)
270I0-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 27-2 .
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH
Support the rear axle carrier with a jack.
Remove the bolt, and disconnect the rear suspension
arm assy No.2 (inner side).
C82992
(c)
Remove the bolt, nut and the rear suspension arm assy
No.2 (outer side) from the rear axle carrier.
NOTICE:
When removing the bolt, keep the nut from rotating.
C82993
G26316
3.
(a)
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM
ASSY NO.2 LH
Install the rear suspension arm assy No.2 (inner side) with
the bolt, and temporarily tighten the bolt.
HINT:
Ensure that the paint mark on the rear suspension arm assy
No.2 faces the rear side of the vehicle.
C82992
Paint Mark
F47191
(b)
Connect the rear suspension arm assy No.2 (outer side)
to the rear axle carrier with the bolt and nut, and temporarily tighten the bolt.
NOTICE:
When installing the bolt, fix the nut and temporarily tighten
the bolt.
C82993
G26316
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2971
27-24
REAR SUSPENSION
4.
-
REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (FF)
STABILIZE SUSPENSION (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
5.
(a)
FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY
NO.2 LH
Fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 120 N⋅m (1,220 kgf⋅cm, 89 ft⋅lbf)
C82992
(b)
C82997
6.
7.
Fully tighten the bolt.
Torque: 112 N⋅m (1,140 kgf⋅cm, 83 ft⋅lbf)
G26317
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2972
28-2
TIRE & WHEEL
-
WHEEL AND TIRE SYSTEM
2804E-01
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
1.
2.
VEHICLE PULLING DIAGNOSIS (SEE PAGE 26-2 )
DIAGNOSIS OF TIRE VIBRATION
Check that the wheel
nuts are fully tightened
NG
NG
Repair
Inspect bearing backlash OK
Inspect axle hud deviation
OK
Check tire pressure
OK
Return the vehicle
to customer
OK
Check wheel balance
OK
NG
NG
Inspect bearing backlash
Adjustment
Replace tire(s)
Adjustment
NG
Inspect axle hud deviation
Repair
NG
OK
Check wheel balance
3.
DIAGNOSIS OF PREMATURE OF IRREGULAR TIRE WEAR
Check tire pressure
OK
Check wheel alignment
NG
NG
Adjustment
Adjustment
OK
Tire rotation or
replace tire(s)
NG
Check wheel alignment
OK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2981
28-1
TIRE & WHEEL
-
WHEEL AND TIRE SYSTEM
WHEEL AND TIRE SYSTEM
28009-14
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT TIRE
Check the tires for wear and proper inflation pressure.
Cold tire inflation pressure:
Tire size
Front, Rear
kPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
P225/70R16 101S
210 (2.1, 30)
Using a dial indicator, check the tire runout.
Tire runout: 1.4 mm (0.055 in.) or less
R03031
2.
ROTATE TIRE
HINT:
See the illustration for where to rotate each tire when you include the spare tire in the rotation and when you do not.
Front
R14931
3.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT WHEEL BALANCE
Check and adjust the Off-the-car balance.
If necessary, check and adjust the On-the-car balance.
Imbalance after adjustment: 8.0 g (0.018 lb) or less
C80976
4.
5.
6.
7.
INSPECT
INSPECT
INSPECT
INSPECT
BEARING BACKLASH (See page 30-3 )
BEARING BACKLASH (See page 30-3 )
AXLE HUB DEVIATION (See page 30-3 )
AXLE HUB DEVIATION (See page 30-3 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2980
29-1
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL SYSTEM (4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL SYSTEM (4WD)
2900W-04
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
Before disassembly, clean the outside of the rear differential assy and remove any sand or mud
to prevent it from entering the inside of the assembly during disassembly and installation.
When removing a connected part made of light alloy such as a rear differential carrier cover,
tap it off with a plastic hammer. Do not attempt to pry it off with a screwdriver.
Always arrange disassembled parts in order and protect them from dust.
Before installation, thoroughly clean and dry each part and then apply hypoid gear oil LSD to
it. Do not use alkaline cleaner for aluminum or rubber parts and ring gear set bolts. Also, do not
clean rubber parts such as O-rings or oil seals with white gasoline.
Coat any sliding surface and rotating part with hypoid gear oil LSD.
When holding a part by vice, be sure to place an aluminum sheet under the part. Do not put it
directly on the vice.
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the case. Such damage may cause oil leakage.
Before applying sealant, remove deposited oil sealant and clean the part to be sealed using
white gasoline.
Do not fill oil immediately after installing sealed parts. Leave it for at least an hour.
Damage on the surface being contact with an oil seal, O-ring or gasket may cause oil leakage.
Special attention should be paid.
When press-fitting an oil seal, be careful not to damage the oil seal lip and outside periphery.
When replacing a bearing, replace the inner and outer races as a set.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2982
29-2
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL SYSTEM (4WD)
2900X-04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The causes of the problem are listed in order
of probability in the ”Suspected Area” column. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
Symptom
Suspected Area
See page
Oil leak from rear differential
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Oil level (Too high or wrong grade)
Rear differential front oil seal (Worn or damaged)
Side gear shaft oil seal (Worn or damaged)
Companion flange (Loose or damaged)
Drive shaft (Damaged)
29-5
29-6
29-9
29-11
30-45
Oil leak from drive pinion shaft
1. Oil level (Too high or wrong grade)
2. Rear differential front oil seal (Worn or damaged)
3. Companion flange (Loose or damaged)
29-5
29-6
29-11
Noise in rear differential
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
29-11
29-11
29-11
29-11
29-11
Oil level (Low or wrong grade)
Excessive backlash between pinion and ring gear
Ring, pinion or side gears (Worn or chipped)
Drive pinion bearing
Side bearing (Worn)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2983
29-5
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL OIL (4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL OIL (4WD)
2900Y-05
ADJUSTMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
0 to 5 mm
(0 to 0.20 in.)
D25304
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL
Stop the vehicle on the level place.
Remove the differential filler plug and gasket.
Check that the oil surface is within 5 mm (0.20 in.) from the
lowest position of the inner surface of the differential filler
plug opening.
NOTICE:
Excessively large or small amount of oil may cause
troubles.
After replacing oil, drive the vehicle and check the oil
level.
HINT:
If nesesary, fill the rear differential carrier assy with hypoid gear
oil.
Oil grade: Hypoid gear oil API GL-5
Recommended oil viscosity:
Above -18°C (0°F) SAE 90
Below -18°C (0°F) SAE 80W or 80W-90
Capacity: 0.9 ± 0.05 liters (0.95 ± 0.05 US qts, 0.79 ±
0.04 lmp. qts)
(d) Check for oil leakage when the oil level is low.
(e) Install the differential filler plug and a new gasket.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2986
29-3
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL (4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL (4WD)
29084-02
COMPONENTS
181 (1,850, 134)
Rear Differential Mount Cushion No.2
95 (970, 70)
Rear Suspension Member Sub-assy
Rear Differential
Mount Cushion
No.1
115 (1,170, 85)
Rear Drive Shaft Assy RH
181 (1,850, 134)
Rear Drive Shaft
Snap Ring RH
294 (3,000, 217)
Rear Axle Shaft RH Nut
115 (1,170, 85)
74 (750, 54)
Differential Carrier Sub-assy Rear
Rear Drive Shaft Assy LH
Propeller w/ Center Bearing
Shaft Assy
Rear Drive Shaft
Snap Ring LH
Rear Differential Support No.1
294 (3,000, 217)
Rear Axle Shaft LH Nut
137 (1,400, 101)
103 (1,050, 76)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
D30569
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2984
29-4
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL (4WD)
Rear Differential Pinion
Shaft Straight Pin
Rear Differential Side Gear
Thrust No.1 Washer
Rear Differential
Pinion Shaft
Differential Side Gear
Differential Pinion Gear
Rear Differential
Case Bearing
Rear Differential
Pinion Thrust Washer
Differential Ring Gear
Rear Differential Side
Shaft Plate Washer
Rear Differential Case
Rear Differential Ring Gear
Set Bolt Lock Plate
Rear Differential
Drive Pinion Plate Washer
97 (989, 71)
Differential
Drive Pinion
Rear Drive Pinion Rear
Tapered Roller Bearing
Rear Differential
Side Gear Shaft
Plate Washer
Rear Differential Side
Gear Shaft Seal Oil
Rear Differential Filler Plug
Rear Differential
Case Bearing
Rear Differential
Breather Plug
Differential Carrier 21 (210, 15)
Sub-assy Rear
Rear Differential
Filler Plug Gasket
X8
47 (475, 34)
Bearing Cap
49 (500, 36)
Rear Differential Drive
Pinion Oil Slinger
Rear Drive Pinion
Front Tapered Roller
Bearing
Rear Differential
Dust Deflector
Rear Differential
Carrier Cover
79 (800, 58)
Rear Differential Side
Rear Differential Drive
Gear Shaft Seal Oil
Pinion Bearing Spacer
Rear Differential
Rear Differential Drain
Carrier Oil Seal
Plug Gasket
49 (500, 36)
Rear Drive Pinion Companion
Rear Differential
Flange Sub-assy Rear
See Page 29-11
Drain Plug
Rear Drive Pinion Nut
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
MP grease
Hypoid gear oil
Non-reusable part
D30570
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2985
29-6
DIFFERENTIAL
-
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL (4WD)
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL (4WD)
2909K-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
(a)
5.
(a)
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-2 )
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
REMOVE PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (SEE PAGE 30-12 )
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL FILLER PLUG
Using a hexagon wrench (10 mm), remove the filler plug and gasket.
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRAIN PLUG
Using a hexagon wrench (10 mm), remove the drain plug and gasket, drain the oil.
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION NUT
Using a chisel and a hammer, unstake the staked part of
the nut.
Using SST to hold the flange, remove the nut.
SST 09330-00021
SST
F40600
7.
SST
(a)
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSY REAR
Using SST, remove the companion flange.
SST 09950- 30012 (09951- 03010, 09953- 03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
D30955
8.
(a)
SST
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DUST DEFLECTOR
Using SST and a press, remove the dust deflector.
SST 09950- 00020, 09950- 60010 (09951- 00360),
09950-70010 (09951-07150)
F40564
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2987
29-7
DIFFERENTIAL
9.
(a)
SST
10.
-
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL (4WD)
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09308-10010
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL
SLINGER
D30956
11.
SST
(a)
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Using SST, remove the front tapered roller bearing.
SST 09556-22010
F40718
12.
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION BEARING SPACER
Rear Diff erent ia l
Drive Pinion
Oil
Slinger
Rear Drive Pinion
Front Tapered
Roller Bearing
Rear Differential Drive Pinion
Bearing Spacer
G24180
13.
(a)
14.
(a)
15.
(a)
16.
(a)
SST
(b)
G24181
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
BEARING SPACER
Install a new bearing spacer.
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Install the tapered roller bearing.
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL
SLINGER
Install the oil slinger.
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, install a new oil seal.
Oil seal drive in depth:
2.0 0.3 mm (0.079 0.012 in.)
Coat MP grease to the oil seal lip.
SST 09554-22010
G25655
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2988
29-8
DIFFERENTIAL
-
REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL (4WD)
17.
(a)
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DUST DEFLECTOR
Using SST and a press, install a new dust deflector.
SST 09223-00010
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the dust deflector.
SST
F40464
18.
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSY REAR
(a) Using SST, install the companion flange on the shaft.
SST 09950- 30012 (09951- 03010, 09953- 03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
NOTICE:
Apply hypoid gear oil to the SST center bolt tip and threads
before use.
SST
D30957
19.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION NUT
Coat the threads of a new nut with hypoid gear oil LSD.
Using SST to hold the flange, torque the nut.
SST 09330-00021
Torque: 108 N·m (1,100 kgf·cm, 80 ft·lbf)
SST
F40601
20.
21.
(a)
22.
23.
(a)
24.
(a)
25.
26.
(a)
27.
28.
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD (SEE PAGE 29-1 1)
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION NUT
Using a chisel and a hammer, stake the drive pinion nut.
INSTALL PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (SEE PAGE 30-12 )
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRAIN PLUG
Using a hexagon wrench (10 mm), install the drain plug and a new gasket.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
ADD DIFFERENTIAL OIL
Fill the rear differential carrier assy with hypoid gear oil.
Oil grade: Hypoid gear oil API GL-5
Recommended oil viscosity:
Above -18°C (0°F) SAE 90
Below -18°C (0°F) SAE 80W or 80W-90
Capacity: 0.9 ± 0.05 liters (0.95 ± 0.05 US qts, 0.79 ± 0.04 lmp. qts)
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL (SEE PAGE 29-5 )
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL FILLER PLUG
Using a hexagon wrench (10 mm), install the filler plug and a new gasket.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-2 )
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2989
DIFFERENTIAL
-
REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT SEAL
OIL (4WD)
29-9
REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT SEAL OIL (4WD)
29085-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
Differential components (See page 29-3 )
Rear drive shaft components (See page 30-4 )
Replace the RH side following the same procedures as with the LH side.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
REMOVE PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 30-12 )
SST 09325-20010
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-2 )
3.
HINT:
Perform this procedure only when removing the RH side.
4.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
5.
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL FILLER PLUG
(a) Using a hexagon wrench (10 mm), remove the filler plug and gasket.
6.
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRAIN PLUG
(a) Using a hexagon wrench (10 mm), remove the drain plug and gasket, and drain the oil.
7.
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
8.
REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
9.
SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
10. SEPARATE STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
11. SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (SEE PAGE 27-25 )
12. REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
13.
SST
(a)
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT
SEAL OIL
Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
G24185
14.
(a)
(b)
SST
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT
SEAL OIL
Using SST and a hammer, install a new oil seal until it is
flush with the carrier end surface.
Oil seal drive in depth:
0 0.5 mm (0 0.019 in.)
Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
SST 09550-00032, 09950-70010 (09951-07200)
G24186
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2990
29-10
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
DIFFERENTIAL
-
REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT SEAL
OIL (4WD)
INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (SEE PAGE 27-25 )
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
SST 09930-00010
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
STABILIZE SUSPENSION (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (SEE PAGE 27-25 )
FULLY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
HINT:
Perform this procedure only when removing the RH side.
26. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-2 )
HINT:
Perform this procedure only when removing the RH side.
27. INSTALL PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 30-12 )
HINT:
Perform this procedure only when removing the RH side.
28. FULLY TIGHTEN PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 30-12 )
HINT:
Perform this procedure only when removing the RH side.
SST 09370-50010
29. INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRAIN PLUG
(a) Using a hexagon wrench (10 mm), install the drain plug and a new gasket.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
30. ADD DIFFERENTIAL OIL
(a) Fill the rear differential carrier assy with hypoid gear oil.
Oil grade: Hypoid gear oil API GL-5
Recommended oil viscosity:
Above -18°C (0°F) SAE 90
Below -18°C (0°F) SAE 80W or 80W-90
Capacity: 0.9 ± 0.05 liters (0.95 ± 0.05 US qts, 0.79 ± 0.04 lmp. qts)
31. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL (SEE PAGE 29-5 )
32. INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL FILLER PLUG
(a) Using a hexagon wrench (10 mm), install the filler plug and a new gasket.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
33. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
34. INSPECT AND ADJUST REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
35. CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
HINT:
Perform this procedure only when removing the RH side.
36. CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
2991
29-1 1
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
2909L-01
OVERHAUL
HINT:
1.
2.
Differential components (see page 29-3 )
Rear drive shaft components (see page 30-45 )
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
REMOVE PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (SEE PAGE 30-12 )
SST 09325-20010
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-2 )
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL FILLER PLUG
Using a hexagon wrench (10 mm), remove the filler plug and gasket.
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRAIN PLUG
Using a hexagon wrench (10 mm), remove the drain plug and gasket, and drain the oil.
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR REAR RH
3.
4.
5.
(a)
6.
(a)
7.
8.
HINT:
Removal procedure of the RH side is the same as that of the LH side.
9.
REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
SST 09930-00010
10. REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT RH NUT
SST 09930-00010
HINT:
Removal procedure of the RH side is the same as that of the LH side.
11. SEPARATE STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
12. SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
13. SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 RH
HINT:
Removal procedure of the RH side is the same as that of the LH side.
14. SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
15. SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 RH
HINT:
Removal procedure of the RH side is the same as that of the LH side.
16. REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
17. REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH
HINT:
Removal procedure of the RH side is the same as that of the LH side.
18. REMOVE REAR SUSPENSION MEMBER SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
Author:
Date:
2992
29-12
DIFFERENTIAL
19.
(a)
(b)
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR
Support the differential carrier assy rear with a jack.
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 lock nuts, and separate the rear
differential support No.1 from the rear suspension member sub-assy.
G24187
(c)
Remove the 3 bolts and differential carrier sub-assy rear
from the rear suspension member sub-assy.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the differential carrier assy rear.
G24188
20.
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL MOUNT CUSHION
NO.1
HINT:
Perform this operation only when the rear differential mount
cushion No.1 is damaged.
(a) Using SST, remove the rear differential mount cushion
No.1.
SST 09570-24010, 09316-12010
NOTICE:
Do not bring SST into contact with the sub-frame.
Do not slant the bolts of SST.
Do not set the SST in the wrong direction.
Screw the 2 bolts of SST equally into the 2 holes of the
rear differential mount.
SST
LH
F53635
Author:
Date:
2993
29-13
DIFFERENTIAL
21.
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL MOUNT CUSHION
NO.2
HINT:
Perform this operation only when the rear differential mount
cushion No.2 is damaged.
(a) Using SST, remove the rear differential mount cushion
No.2.
SST 09570-24010, 09316-12010
NOTICE:
Do not bring SST into contact with the sub-frame.
Do not slant the bolt of SST.
Do not set the SST in the wrong direction.
SST
RH
F53636
22.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL SUPPORT NO.1
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 lock nuts and rear differential support No.1 from the differential carrier sub-assy rear.
23.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER COVER
Remove the 8 bolts from the carrier cover.
Using a brass bar and a hammer, separate the carrier cover from differential carrier sub-assy.
Remove the breather plug from the differential carrier cover.
G24189
(c)
G21126
24.
FIX DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR
G21127
Author:
Date:
2994
29-14
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
25.
(a)
INSPECT RUNOUT OF DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
Using a dial indicator, check the runout of the ring gear.
Maximum runout: 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the runout is greater than the maximum, replace the ring gear
with a new one.
G21128
26.
(a)
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR BACKLASH
Using a dial indicator, check the backlash of the ring gear.
Backlash: 0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification, adjust the side
bearing preload or repair as necessary.
G21129
27.
F01259
G22651
30 mm (1.18 in.)
INSPECT TOOTH CONTACT BETWEEN RING GEAR
AND DRIVE PINION
(a) Coat 3 or 4 teeth at 3 different positions on the ring gear
with red lead primer.
(b) Hold the companion flange firmly and rotate the ring gear
in both directions.
(c) Inspect the contact pattern.
If tooth contact pattern is not correct, replace the adjusting
washer installed on the front of the drive pinion rear bearing to
adjust it.
28. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL PINION AND SIDE GEAR
BACKLASH
(a) Using a dial indicator, check the backlash of the side gear
while holding 1 pinion gear toward the differential case.
Backlash: 0.05 to 0.20 mm (0.0020 to 0.0079 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification, install the 2 side
gear thrust washers of different thickness (See step 52).
HINT:
Measure the backlash of the side gear with the side gear shaft
installed.
29. INSPECT RUNOUT OF REAR DRIVE PINION
COMPANION FLANGE SUB-ASSY REAR
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the runout of the companion flange vertically and horizontally.
Maximum runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the runout is greater than the maximum, replace the rear drive
pinion companion flange sub-assy rear.
F01237
Author:
Date:
2995
29-15
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
30.
(a)
SA2352
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the drive
pinion.
Preload (at starting):
0.6 to 0.9 N·m (6 to 9 kgf·cm, 5.2 to 7.8 in.·lbf)
If the preload is not within the specification, adjust the rear differential drive pinion preload or repair as necessary.
HINT:
This preload is within the backlash between the drive pinion and
ring gear.
31. INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
(a) Using a torque wrench, measure the total preload.
Total preload (at starting): Drive pinion preload plus
0.3 to 0.5 N·m (3 to 5 kgf·cm, 2.6 to 4.3 in.·lbf)
If the total preload is not within the specification, adjust the total
preload or repair as necessary.
HINT:
Disassemble and inspect the differential as necessary.
SA2352
32.
SST
(a)
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT
SEAL OIL
Using SST, remove the 2 oil seals from the housing.
SST 09308-00010
F01241
33.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION NUT
Using SST and a hammer, unstake the staked part of the
nut.
SST 09930-00010
(b)
Using SST to hold the flange, remove the nut.
SST 09330-00021
SST
C60487
G24173
SST
SA2349
Author:
Date:
2996
29-16
DIFFERENTIAL
34.
(a)
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSY REAR
Using SST, remove the companion flange.
SST 09950- 30012 (09951- 03010, 09953- 03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
SST
R11391
SST
35.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DUST DEFLECTOR
Using SST and a press, remove the dust deflector.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00360), 09950- 70010
(09951-07150), 09950-00020
36.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
Using SST, remove the oil seal from the differential carrier.
SST 09308-10010
F40564
SST
SA2348
37.
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL SLINGER
38.
SST
(a)
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Using SST, remove the front bearing from the drive pinion.
SST 09556-22010
Z00641
39.
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION BEARING SPACER
Author:
Date:
2997
29-17
DIFFERENTIAL
40.
(a)
Matchmarks
(b)
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSY
Align matchmarks on the bearing cap and differential carrier.
Remove the 4 bolts and 2 bearing caps.
F03753
(c)
SST
Using SST and a hammer, remove the 2 plate washers.
SST 09504-2201 1
HINT:
Measure the thickness of the plate washers and note it down.
C67710
(d)
Remove the differential case assy and the 2 bearing outer
races from the differential carrier.
HINT:
Tag the 2 bearing outer races to show the location for reassembly.
C68107
41.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
42.
SST
(a)
R10668
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION REAR TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Using SST and a press, remove the rear bearing from the
drive pinion.
SST 09950-00020
HINT:
If either the drive pinion or ring gear is damaged, replace both
as a set.
(b) Remove the plate washer.
Author:
Date:
2998
29-18
DIFFERENTIAL
43.
(a)
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the front bearing (outer race) from the carrier.
C51361
44.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION REAR TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the rear bearing
(outer race) from the carrier.
C51362
45.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Matchmarks
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
Align matchmarks on the ring gear and differential case.
Using a screwdriver and a hammer, unstake the 4 lock
plates.
Remove the 8 ring gear set bolts and 4 lock plates.
Using a plastic hammer, tap on the ring gear to separate
it from the differential case.
F03755
46.
(a)
(b)
C68112
SST
SST
INSPECT RUNOUT OF DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSY
Install the differential case to the differential carrier.
Install the right and left bearing caps with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 79 N⋅m (800 kgf⋅cm, 58 ft⋅lbf)
(c) Using a dial indicator, measure the differential case runout.
Maximum case runout: 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the runout is greater than the maximum, replace the differential case assy with a new one.
(d) Remove the differential case.
47. REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL CASE BEARING
(a) Using SST, remove the case bearing (LH) from the differential case.
SST 09950- 40011 (09951- 04020, 09952- 04010,
09953- 04030, 09954- 04010, 09955- 04061,
09957- 04010, 09958- 04011), 09950- 60010
(09951-00360)
F40345
Author:
Date:
2999
29-19
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
48.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL CASE BEARING
Using SST, remove the case bearing (RH) from the differential case.
SST 09950- 40011 (09951- 04020, 09952- 04010,
09953- 04030, 09954- 04010, 09955- 04061,
09957- 04010, 09958- 04011), 09950- 60010
(09951-00360)
49.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL PINION SHAFT
Using a pin punch (5 mm) and a hammer, remove the
straight pin.
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Remove
Remove
Remove
Remove
Remove
SST
SST
F40346
C63262
[C]
[D]
[B]
[E]
[B]
the
the
the
the
the
differential pinion shaft. [A]
2 differential pinion gears. [B]
2 differential pinion thrust washers. [C]
2 side gears. [D]
2 side gear thrust washers. [E]
[E]
[A]
[C]
[D]
ZK1879
50. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL PINION AND SIDE GEAR
(a) Check that there is no damage to the differential pinion gear and side gear.
If the differential pinion gear and/or side gear is damaged, replace them with new ones.
51. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Check that there is no damage to the differential case.
If the differential case is damaged, replace it.
52.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL PINION SHAFT
Install the 2 thrust washers to the 2 side gears.
Install the 2 side gears, 2 differential pinion gears, 2 differential pinion thrust washers and differential pinion shaft to
the differential case.
HINT:
Align the holes of the differential case and differential pinion shaft.
FA1121
Author:
Date:
3000
29-20
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
53.
(a)
ZD7930
ADJUST DIFFERENTIAL PINION GEAR BACKLASH
Measure the side gear backlash while holding 1 pinion
gear toward the differential case.
Backlash: 0.05 to 0.20 mm (0.0020 to 0.0079 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification, install the 2 side
gear thrust washers of different thicknesses.
HINT:
Refer to the following table to select 2 thrust washers.
Thrust washer thickness:
Thickness
(b)
(c)
mm (in.)
Thickness
mm (in.)
0.93 to 0.97 (0.0366 to 0.0382)
1.18 to 1.22 (0.0465 to 0.0480)
0.98 to 1.02 (0.0386 to 0.0402)
1.23 to 1.27 (0.0484 to 0.0500)
1.03 to 1.07 (0.0406 to 0.0421)
1.28 to 1.32 (0.0504 to 0.0520)
1.08 to 1.12 (0.0425 to 0.0441)
1.33 to 1.37 (0.0524 to 0.0539)
1.13 to 1.17 (0.0445 to 0.0461)
1.38 to 1.42 (0.0543 to 0.0559)
Using a pin punch (5 mm) and a hammer, install the
straight pin through the differential case and hole of the
pinion shaft.
Using a chisel and a hammer, stake the outside of the differential case pin hole.
FA1124
54.
(a)
Boiling Water
(b)
(c)
(d)
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
Clean the contact surfaces of the differential case and
ring gear.
Heat the ring gear to approx. 100°C (212°F) in boiling water.
Carefully take the ring gear out of the boiling water.
After the moisture on the ring gear has completely evaporated, quickly install the ring gear to the differential case.
SA1143
(e)
(f)
(g)
Matchmarks
F03758
Align the matchmarks on the ring gear and differential
case.
Temporarily install 4 new lock plates and 8 bolts.
After the ring gear cools down enough, torque the 8 bolts
uniformly.
Torque: 97 N·m (989 kgf·cm, 71 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Tighten the bolts, in diagonal order, a little at a time until they
are all tightened.
Author:
Date:
3001
29-21
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
(h)
Using a chisel and a hammer, stake the 4 lock plates.
(1) Stake one claw so that it is flush against the flat surface of the bolt.
(2) As for the other claw, stake it against the surface of
the bolt head so as to act as a stopper if the bolt
starts to loosen.
55.
(a)
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL CASE BEARING
Using SST and a press, install the case bearing (RH) to
the differential case.
SST 09636-20010
56.
(a)
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL CASE BEARING
Using SST and a press, install the case bearing (LH) to
the differential case.
SST 09636-20010
(2)
(1)
Z02483
SST
F40347
SST
F40463
57.
(a)
C68116
INSPECT RUNOUT OF DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR
Install the differential case to the carrier, and install the 2
plate washers so that there is no play in the bearing.
(b) Install the 2 bearing caps with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 79 N·m (800 kgf·cm, 58 ft·lbf)
(c) Using a dial indicator, measure the runout of the ring gear.
Maximum runout: 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the runout is greater than the maximum, replace the drive pinion, ring gear and differential case.
(d) Remove the 2 bearing caps, 2 plate washers and differential carrier.
Author:
Date:
3002
29-22
DIFFERENTIAL
58.
SST
(a)
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Using SST and a press, install the front bearing (outer
race) to the carrier.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00620), 09950- 70010
(09951-07150)
F40461
59.
SST
(a)
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION REAR TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Using SST and a press, install the rear bearing (outer
race) to the carrier.
SST 09950- 60020 (09951- 00710), 09950- 70010
(09951-07150)
F40462
60.
(a)
(b)
SST
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION REAR TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Install the removed plate washer to the drive pinion.
Using SST and a press, install the rear bearing to the drive
pinion.
SST 09506-30012
SA3102
61. ADJUST DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Install the drive pinion and front bearing.
HINT:
Assemble the spacer and oil seal after adjusting the gear contact pattern.
F01250
(b)
Install the rear differential drive pinion oil slinger to the
drive pinion.
G21132
Author:
Date:
3003
29-23
DIFFERENTIAL
(c)
(d)
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
Using SST, install the companion flange.
SST 09950- 30012 (09951- 03010, 09953- 03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
Coat the threads of the nut with hypoid gear oil LSD.
SST
R11163
(e)
Using SST to hold the flange, torque the nut.
SST 09330-00021
Torque: 108 N·m (1,100 kgf·cm, 80 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Torque the nut a little at a time, being careful not to
overtighten it.
Apply hypoid gear oil LSD to the nut.
SST
SA2351
(f)
Using a torque wrench, measure the preload.
Drive pinion preload (at starting):
New bearing:
1.1 to 1.7 N·m (11 to 17 kgf·cm, 9.6 to 14.8 in.·lbf)
Reused bearing:
0.6 to 0.9 N·m (6 to 9 kgf·cm, 5.2 to 7.8 in.·lbf)
If the preload is not within the specification, adjust the differential drive pinion preload or repair as necessary.
SA2352
62.
(a)
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSY
Place the 2 bearing outer races on their respective bearings. Make sure the right and left races are
not interchanged.
Author:
Date:
3004
29-24
DIFFERENTIAL
63.
(a)
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
ADJUST DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR BACKLASH
Install the right and left bearing caps with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 79 N·m (800 kgf·cm, 58 ft·lbf)
HINT:
F01239
When using a new side bearing select a thrust shim which
is thinner than the removed one.
If the side bearing is reused, select a thrust shim of the
same thickness as the removed one.
(b) Make snug the differential case bearing and thrust shim
by tapping on the ring gear with a plastic hammer.
(c) Set the dial indicator perpendicular to the end of the ring
gear face.
(d) While holding the rear drive pinion companion flange rear,
rotate the ring gear and measure the backlash.
Backlash: 0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
NOTICE:
Measure it at 3 points or more on the ring gear periphery.
If the measured value is out of the specified value, select a proper thrust shim so that the backlash of the differential ring gear
is within the value, and install it to the ring gear back side.
Washer thickness:
Thickness
mm (in.)
Thickness
mm (in.)
Thickness
mm (in.)
2.21 to 2.23 (0.0870 to 0.0878)
2.57 to 2.59 (0.1012 to 0.1020)
2.93 to 2.95 (0.1154 to 0.1161)
2.24 to 2.26 (0.0882 to 0.0890)
2.60 to 2.62 (0.1024 to 0.1031)
2.96 to 2.98 (0.1165 to 0.1173)
2.27 to 2.29 (0.0894 to 0.0902)
2.63 to 2.65 (0.1035 to 0.1043)
2.99 to 3.01 (0.1177 to 0.1185)
2.30 to 2.32 (0.0906 to 0.0913)
2.66 to 2.68 (0.1047 to 0.1055)
3.02 to 3.04 (0.1189 to 0.1197)
2.33 to 2.35 (0.0917 to 0.0925)
2.69 to 2.71 (0.1059 to 0.1067)
3.05 to 3.07 (0.1201 to 0.1209)
2.36 to 2.38 (0.0929 to 0.0937)
2.72 to 2.74 (0.1071 to 0.1079)
3.08 to 3.10 (0.1213 to 0.1220)
2.39 to 2.41 (0.0941 to 0.0949)
2.75 to 2.77 (0.1083 to 0.1091)
3.11 to 3.13 (0.1224 to 0.1232)
2.42 to 2.44 (0.0953 to 0.0961)
2.78 to 2.80 (0.1094 to 0.1102)
3.14 to 3.16 (0.1236 to 0.1244)
2.45 to 2.47 (0.0965 to 0.0972)
2.81 to 2.83 (0.1106 to 0.1114)
3.17 to 3.19 (0.1248 to 0.1256)
2.48 to 2.50 (0.0976 to 0.0984)
2.84 to 2.86 (0.1118 to 0.1126)
3.20 to 3.22 (0.1260 to 0.1268)
2.51 to 2.53 (0.0988 to 0.0996)
2.87 to 2.89 (0.1130 to 0.1138)
-
2.54 to 2.56 (0.1000 to 0.1008)
2.90 to 2.92 (0.1142 to 0.1150)
-
64.
(a)
(b)
(c)
ADJUST TOTAL PRELOAD
After adjusting the backlash of the differential ring gear,
remove the teeth side thrust shim.
Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the removed thrust shim.
Select a new thrust shim 0.06 to 0.09 mm (0.0024 to
0.0035 in.) which is thicker than the removed one.
HINT:
Select a thrust shim which can be pressed in 2/3 rds of the way
by finger.
Author:
Date:
3005
29-25
DIFFERENTIAL
(d)
SST
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
Using SST and a plastic hammer, drive in the thrust shim.
SST 09504-2201 1
F40494
(e)
Align matchmarks on the bearing cap and differential carrier, and install the 2 bearing caps.
NOTICE:
Make sure the right and left bearing caps are not interchanged.
(f)
Tighten both bearing caps with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 79 N·m (800 kgf·cm, 58 ft·lbf)
F03753
(g)
C68124
Set the dial indicator to the end of the differential ring gear
face.
(h) While holding the rear drive pinion companion flange rear,
rotate the differential ring gear and measure the backlash.
Backlash: 0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
(i)
If the measured value is out of the specified value, adjust
it by increasing or decreasing the thickness of both right
and left thrust shims equally.
SST 09504-2201 1
(j)
Using a torque wrench, measure the preload.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus 0.3 to 0.5 N·m (3 to 5 kgf·cm,
2.6 to 4.3 in.·lbf)
If the preload is not within the specification, adjust the total preload or repair as necessary.
SA2352
65.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT TOOTH CONTACT BETWEEN RING GEAR
AND DRIVE PINION
Coat 3 or 4 teeth at 3 different positions on the ring gear
with red lead primer.
Hold the companion flange firmly and rotate the ring gear
in both directions.
F01259
Author:
Date:
3006
29-26
DIFFERENTIAL
(c)
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
Inspect the tooth contact pattern.
Heel Contact
Face Contact
Proper Contact
Select an adjusting washer that brings the
drive pinion closer to the ring gear.
Toe Contact
Flank Contact
Select an adjusting washer that shifts the
drive pinion away from the ring gear.
SA1653
If the teeth are not contacting properly, use the following table
to select a proper washer for correction.
Plate Washer
SA1586
Washer thickness:
Thickness
66.
67.
68.
69.
mm (in.)
Thickness
mm (in.)
Thickness
mm (in.)
2.26 to 2.28 (0.0890 to 0.0898)
2.41 to 2.43 (0.0949 to 0.0957)
2.56 to 2.58 (0.1008 to 0.1016)
2.29 to 2.31 (0.0902 to 0.0909)
2.44 to 2.46 (0.0961 to 0.0969)
2.59 to 2.61 (0.1020 to 0.1028)
2.32 to 2.34 (0.0913 to 0.0921)
2.47 to 2.49 (0.0972 to 0.0980)
2.62 to 2.64 (0.1031 to 0.1039)
2.35 to 2.37 (0.0925 to 0.0933)
2.50 to 2.52 (0.0984 to 0.0992)
2.65 to 2.67 (0.1043 to 0.1051)
2.38 to 2.40 (0.0937 to 0.0945)
2.53 to 2.55 (0.0996 to 0.1004)
2.68 to 2.70 (0.1055 to 0.1063)
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION NUT (SEE STEP 33)
SST 09330-00021
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION COMPANION FLANGE SUB-ASSY REAR (SEE STEP 34)
SST 09950-30012 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
REMOVE REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL SLINGER
REMOVE REAR DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED ROLLER BEARING (SEE STEP 38)
SST 09556-22010
Author:
Date:
3007
29-27
DIFFERENTIAL
70.
(a)
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION BEARING SPACER
Install a new bearing spacer.
71.
(a)
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION FRONT TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Install the rear drive pinion front tapered roller bearing to
the drive pinion.
F01250
72.
(a)
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION OIL
SLINGER
Install the rear differential drive pinion oil slinger to the
drive pinion.
G21132
73.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, install a new oil seal.
SST 09554-22010
Oil seal drive in depth:
2.0 0.3 mm (0.079 0.012 in.)
Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
SST
F01261
74.
(a)
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DUST DEFLECTOR
Using SST and a press, install a new dust deflector.
SST 09223-00010
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the dust deflector.
SST
F40464
Author:
Date:
3008
29-28
DIFFERENTIAL
75.
(a)
(b)
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION COMPANION FLANGE
SUB-ASSY REAR
Using SST, install the companion flange to the drive pinion.
SST 09950- 30012 (09951- 03010, 09953- 03010,
09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
Coat the threads of a new nut with hypoid gear oil LSD.
SST
R11163
(c)
SST
Using SST to hold the flange, torque the nut.
SST
09330-00021
Torque: 108 N⋅m (1,100 kgf⋅cm, 80 ft⋅lbf)
SA2351
76.
(a)
SA2352
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the drive
pinion.
Preload (at starting):
New bearing:
1.1 to 1.7 N·m (11 to 17 kgf·cm, 9.6 to 14.8 in.·lbf)
Reused bearing:
0.6 to 0.9 N·m (6 to 9 kgf·cm, 5.2 to 7.8 in.·lbf)
If the preload is greater than the specification, replace the bearing spacer.
If the preload is less than the specification, retorque
the nut with 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf) of torque
at a time until the specified preload is reached.
Torque: 108 to 235 N·m (1,100 to 2,400 kgf·cm, 80 to
174 ft⋅lbf)
If the torque exceeds the maximum while retightening the nut, replace the bearing spacer and repeat
the preload adjusting procedure.
NOTICE:
Do not loosen the pinion nut to reduce the preload.
HINT:
This preload is within the backlash between the drive pinion and
ring gear.
Author:
Date:
3009
29-29
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
77.
(a)
INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
Using a torque wrench, measure the preload.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus 0.3 to 0.5 N·m (3 to 5 kgf·cm,
2.6 to 4.3 in.·lbf)
If the total preload is not within the specification, adjust the total
preload or repair as necessary.
SA2352
78.
(a)
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL RING GEAR BACKLASH
Using a dial indicator, check the backlash of the ring gear.
Backlash: 0.13 to 0.18 mm (0.0051 to 0.0071 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification, adjust the side
bearing preload or repair as necessary.
G21129
79.
INSPECT RUNOUT OF REAR DRIVE PINION
COMPANION FLANGE SUB-ASSY REAR
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the runout of the companion flange vertically and horizontally.
Maximum runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the runout is greater than the maximum, replace the rear drive
pinion companion flange sub-assy rear.
30 mm (1.18 in.)
80.
(a)
F01237
INSTALL REAR DRIVE PINION NUT
Using a chisel and hammer, stake the drive pinion nut.
81.
(a)
SST
F01262
(b)
82.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL SIDE GEAR SHAFT
SEAL OIL
Using SST and a hammer, install 2 new oil seals.
SST 09550-00032, 09950-70010 (09951-07200)
Oil seal drive in depth:
0 0.5 mm (0 0.019 in.)
Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER COVER
Install the breather plug to the carrier cover.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (210 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Clean contacting surfaces of any residual FIPG material
using gasoline or alcohol.
Author:
Date:
3010
29-30
DIFFERENTIAL
(c)
2 to 3 mm
(0.08 to 0.12 in.)
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
Apply FIPG to the carrier.
FIPG:
08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
HINT:
F03983
-
(d)
FIPG should be applied 2 to 3 mm (0.08 to 0.12 in.) in diameter with no break.
Allow for an overlap of 10 mm (0.39 in.) or more between
the start and end of FIPG application.
Install the carrier cover within 3 minutes after applying
FIPG.
Do not add oil immediately after installing the cover, and
leave differential carrier as is for at least an hour.
Also, for 12 hours or more, avoid rapid acceleration/deceleration.
Install the carrier cover with the 8 bolts.
Torque: 47 N⋅m (475 kgf⋅cm, 34 ft⋅lbf)
G21126
83.
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL MOUNT CUSHION
NO.1
(a) Using SST, install a new rear differential mount cushion
No.1.
SST 09570-24010
NOTICE:
Do not set the SST in the wrong direction.
HINT:
Perform this operation only when the rear differential mount
cushion No.1 replaced.
SST
LH
F53634
Author:
Date:
3011
29-31
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
84.
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL MOUNT CUSHION
NO.2
(a) Using SST, install a new rear differential mount cushion
No.2.
SST 09570-24010
NOTICE:
Do not set the SST in the wrong direction.
HINT:
Perform this operation only when the rear differential mount
cushion No.2 replaced.
SST
RH
F53633
85.
(a)
INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL SUPPORT NO.1
Install the rear differential support No.1 to the differential
carrier assy rear with the 2 bolts and 2 lock nuts.
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
86.
(a)
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR
Jack up the differential carrier assy rear and rear suspension member with a jack.
Connect the rear differential support No.1 to the rear suspension member with 2 bolts and 2 lock nuts.
Torque: 137 N⋅m (1,400 kgf⋅cm, 101 ft⋅lbf)
G24189
(b)
G24187
(c)
Install the differential carrier assy rear to the rear suspension member sub-assy with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 95 N⋅m (970 kgf⋅cm, 70 ft⋅lbf)
G24188
Author:
Date:
3012
29-32
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
87. INSTALL REAR SUSPENSION MEMBER SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
88. INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
89. INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH
HINT:
Installation procedure of the RH side is the same as that of the LH side.
90. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
91. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 RH
HINT:
Installation procedure of the RH side is the same as that of the LH side.
92. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
93. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 RH
HINT:
Installation procedure of the RH side is the same as that of the LH side.
94. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
95. INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
SST 09930-00010
96. INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT RH NUT
SST 09930-00010
HINT:
Installation procedure of the RH side is the same as that of the LH side.
97. INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (SEE PAGE 30-45 )
98. INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR RH
HINT:
Installation procedure of the RH side is the same as that of the LH side.
99. STABILIZE SUSPENSION (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
100. FULLY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
101. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
102. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 RH
HINT:
Installation procedure of the RH side is the same as that of the LH side.
103. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
104. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 RH
HINT:
Installation procedure of the RH side is the same as that of the LH side.
105. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
106. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-2 )
107. INSTALL PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (SEE PAGE 30-12 )
108. FULLY TIGHTEN PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (SEE PAGE 30-12 )
SST 09370-50010
109. INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL DRAIN PLUG
(a) Using a hexagon wrench (10 mm), install the drain plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
110. ADD DIFFERENTIAL OIL
(a) Fill the rear differential carrier assy with hypoid gear oil.
Oil grade: Hypoid gear oil API GL-5
Recommended oil viscosity:
Above -18°C (0°F) SAE 90
Below -18°C (0°F) SAE 80W or 80W-90
Capacity: 0.9 ± 0.05 liters (0.95 ± 0.05 US qts, 0.79 ± 0.04 lmp. qts)
111. INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL (SEE PAGE 29-5 )
Author:
Date:
3013
29-33
DIFFERENTIAL
-
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER ASSY REAR (4WD)
112. INSTALL REAR DIFFERENTIAL FILLER PLUG
(a) Using a hexagon wrench (10 mm), install the filler plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
113. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
114. INSPECT AND ADJUST REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
115. CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
116. CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-763 )
Author:
Date:
3014
30-3
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
DRIVE SHAFT, PROPELLER SHAFT, AXLE
3001V-09
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT FRONT AXLE HUB BEARING LOOSENESS
Using a dial indicator, check for looseness near the center
of the axle hub.
Maximum: 0 mm (0 in.)
If looseness exceeds the maximum, replace the bearing.
NOTICE:
Ensure that the dial indicator is set at right angles to the
measurement surface.
D26919
2.
(a)
INSPECT FRONT AXLE HUB BEARING RUNOUT
Using a dial indicator, check for runout in the surface of
the axle hub outside the hub bolt.
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If runout exceeds the maximum, replace the axle hub.
NOTICE:
Ensure that the dial indicator is set at right angles to the
measurement surface.
D26920
3.
(a)
INSPECT REAR AXLE HUB BEARING LOOSENESS
Using a dial indicator, check for looseness near the center
of the axle hub.
Maximum: 0 mm (0 in.)
If looseness exceeds the maximum, replace the axle hub assy.
NOTICE:
Ensure that the dial indicator is set at right angles to the
measurement surface.
C98686
4.
(a)
INSPECT REAR AXLE HUB BEARING RUNOUT
Using a dial indicator, check for runout in the surface of
the axle hub outside the hub bolt.
Maximum: 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If runout exceeds the maximum, replace the axle hub assy.
NOTICE:
Ensure that the dial indicator is set at right angles to the
measurement surface.
C98687
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3017
30-1
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
DRIVE SHAFT, PROPELLER SHAFT, AXLE
DRIVE SHAFT, PROPELLER SHAFT, AXLE
300K2-04
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
NOTICE OF REMOVING AND INSTALLING FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH
When removing and installing the front drive shaft assy RH in a 4WD vehicle, be sure to first drain all
the transaxle oil and transfer oil. If removal and installation is carried out without draining these oils,
the transfer oil will flow into the transaxle side. Extensive cleaning will be required if the two oils mix.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3015
30-2
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
DRIVE SHAFT, PROPELLER SHAFT, AXLE
3001U-15
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the problem. The causes of problem are listed
in order of probability in the ”Suspected Area” column. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
Symptom
Suspected Area
See page
Wander
6. Wheel alignment (Front)
7. Wheel alignment (Rear)
8. Steering linkage (Loosen or worn)
9. Hub bearing (Worn)
10.Stabilizer bar (Front [2WD])
11.Stabilizer bar (Front [4WD])
12.Stabilizer bar (Rear [2WD])
13.Stabilizer bar (Rear [4WD])
26-7
27-5
30-3
26-22
26-25
27-27
27-29
Front wheel shimmy
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
28-1
26-12
27-7
26-20
30-3
Noise (Front drive shaft)
1. Inboard or outboard joint (Worn) (2WD)
2. Inboard or outboard joint (Worn) (4WD)
30-21
30-21
Noise (Rear drive shaft)
1. Inboard or outboard joint (Worn)
30-45
Noise (Propeller shaft)
1. Sleeve yoke spline (Worn)
2. Center support bearing (Worn)
3. Spider bearing (Worn or stuck)
30-12
30-12
30-12
Vibration (Propeller shaft)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
30-12
30-12
30-12
30-12
30-12
30-12
Wheel balance
Shock absorber (Front)
Shock absorber (Rear)
Ball joint (Worn)
Hub bearing (Worn)
Propeller and intermediate shafts (Runout)
Propeller shafts (Imbalance)
Front flange (Runout)
Rear flange (Runout)
Universal joint (Stuck or damaged)
Sleeve yoke spline (Stuck)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3016
30-45
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
REAR DRIVE SHAFT (4WD)
REAR DRIVE SHAFT (4WD)
300OK-01
OVERHAUL
HINT:
COMPONENTS: SEE PAGE 30-4
Overhaul the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR REAR LH
(a) Remove the bolt and the speed sensor from the axle carrier.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the speed sensor.
Prevent foreign matter from adhering to the speed sensor.
3.
(a)
SST
C89299
F45049
REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT
Using SST and a hammer, unstake the staked part of the
axle shaft LH nut.
SST 09930-00010
NOTICE:
Loosen the staked part of the nut completely, otherwise the
screw of the drive shaft may be damaged.
(b) While applying the brakes, remove the lock axle shaft LH
nut.
4.
5.
6.
7.
(a)
SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
SEPARATE STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
SEPARATE REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH
Push the rear axle carrier sub-assy LH toward the outside of the vehicle, using a plastic hammer, separate the rear drive shaft assy LH from the rear axle carrier sub-assy LH.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the joint boot and speed sensor rotor.
Do not push out the rear axle carrier sub-assy LH excessively.
8.
REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH
(a) Remove the rear drive shaft, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Move the drive shaft assy while keeping it level.
G24056
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3059
30-46
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
REAR DRIVE SHAFT (4WD)
INSPECT REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH
Check that there is no remarkable play in the radial direction of the outboard joint.
Check that the inboard joint slides smoothly in the thrust direction.
Check that there is no remarkable play in the radial direction of the inboard joint.
Check the boots for damage.
10. REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT INBOARD JOINT
BOOT LH CLAMP
(a) Using pliers, remove the inboard joint boot LH clamp, as
shown in the illustration.
G20980
11.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT INBOARD JOINT
BOOT RH NO.2 CLAMP
Using pliers, remove the inboard joint boot LH No.2
clamp, as shown in the illustration.
G20981
12.
(a)
SEPARATE INBOARD JOINT BOOT
Separate the inboard joint boot from the inboard joint assy.
13.
REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT INBOARD JOINT
ASSY LH
(a) Put matchmarks on the inboard joint assy and outboard
joint shaft.
NOTICE:
Do not punch the marks.
(b) Remove the inboard joint assy from the outboard joint
shaft.
Matchmarks
F40222
(c)
Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
G24058
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3060
30-47
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
REAR DRIVE SHAFT (4WD)
(d)
Matchmarks
N00194
Put matchmarks on the outboard joint shaft and tripod
joint.
NOTICE:
Do not punch the marks.
(e) Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the tripod joint
from the outboard joint shaft.
NOTICE:
Do not tap the roller.
(f)
Remove the inboard joint boot, inboard joint boot LH
clamp and inboard joint boot LH No.2 clamp.
14. REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT OUTBOARD JOINT
BOOT LH CLAMP
(a) Using pliers, remove the outboard joint boot LH clamp, as
shown in the illustration.
G20982
15.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT OUTBOARD JOINT
BOOT LH NO.2 CLAMP
Using pliers, remove the outboard joint boot LH No.2
clamp, as shown in the illustration.
G21590
16. REMOVE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
(a) Remove the outboard joint boot from the outboard joint shaft.
(b) Remove the old grease from the outboard joint.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the outboard joint.
17. REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT INBOARD JOINT LH SHAFT SNAP RING
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the shaft snap ring.
18.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER LH
Using SST and a press, remove the drive shaft dust cover
LH.
SST 09950-00020
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the inboard joint assy.
Do not overtighten the SST.
SST
C68353
F45514
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3061
30-48
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
REAR DRIVE SHAFT (4WD)
19.
(a)
INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER LH
Using SST and a steel plate, install a new drive shaft dust
cover LH
SST 09527-2101 1
NOTICE:
Dust cover should be completely installed.
Be careful not to damage the dust cover.
Steel Plate
SST
C68354
20.
(a)
-
F45515
INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT INBOARD JOINT LH SHAFT SNAP RING
Install a new hole snap ring.
21. INSTALL OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
HINT:
Before installing the boot, wrap the spline of the outboard joint
shaft with vinyl tape to prevent the boot from being damaged.
(a) Install a new outboard joint boot, 2 outboard joint boot
clamps, 2 inboard joint boot clamps and inboard joint
boot.
(b) Make sure that the 2 boots are on the shaft groove.
Vinyl Tape
RA1310
22.
Hold
SST
Turn
R10425
INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT OUTBOARD JOINT
BOOT LH CLAMP
Hold the drive shaft lightly in a soft vise.
Install the 2 outboard joint boot clamps to the boot.
(a)
(b)
HINT:
Before installing the clamps, pack the outboard joint and boot
with grease in the boot kit.
Grease capacity: 95 to 105 g (3.4 to 3.7 oz.)
(c) Place SST onto the outboard joint boot LH clamp.
SST 09521-24010
(d) Tighten the SST so that the outboard joint boot LH clamp
is pinched.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
(e)
Using SST, measure the clearance of the outboard joint
boot LH clamp.
SST 09240-00020
Clearance: 1.3 mm (0.051 in.) or less
NOTICE:
When the measured value is greater than the specified value, retighten the clamp.
SST
R10426
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3062
30-49
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
REAR DRIVE SHAFT (4WD)
23.
INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT OUTBOARD JOINT
BOOT LH NO.2 CLAMP
(a) Place SST onto the outboard joint boot LH No.2 clamp.
SST 09521-24010
(b) Tighten the SST so that the outboard joint boot LH No.2
clamp is pinched.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
Turn
Hold
SST
G21594
(c)
Using SST, measure the clearance of the outboard joint
boot LH No.2 clamp.
SST
09240-00020
Clearance: 1.3 mm (0.051 in.) or less
NOTICE:
When the measured value is greater than the specified value, retighten the clamp.
SST
G21598
24.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT INBOARD JOINT ASSY
LH
Place the beveled side of the tripod joint axial spline toward the outboard joint shaft.
Align the matchmarks.
Matchmarks
C58023
F40930
(c)
Using a brass bar and a hammer, tap in the tripod joint to
the outboard joint shaft.
NOTICE:
Do not tap the roller.
Be sure to install the tripod joint assy in the correct
direction.
F40931
(d)
(e)
Using a snap ring expander, install a new shaft snap ring.
Pack the outboard joint shaft and boot with grease.
Grease capacity : 125.5 to 135.5 g (4.4 to 4.7 oz.)
G24058
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3063
30-50
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
(f)
Matchmarks
-
REAR DRIVE SHAFT (4WD)
Align the matchmarks, install the inboard joint assy to the
outboard joint shaft assy.
F40222
25.
(a)
INSTALL INBOARD JOINT BOOT
Install the inboard joint boot to the outboard joint shaft.
SST
26.
Hold
Turn
G21591
INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT INBOARD JOINT BOOT
LH CLAMP
(a) Install the inboard joint boot LH clamp.
(1) Hold the drive shaft lightly in a soft vise.
(2) Install the 2 inboard joint boot clamps to the boot.
(3) Place SST onto the inboard joint boot LH clamp.
SST 09521-24010
(4) Tighten the SST so that the inboard joint boot LH
clamp is pinched.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
(5)
Using SST, measure the clearance of the inboard
joint boot LH clamp.
SST 09240-00020
Clearance: 1.1 mm (0.043 in.) or less
NOTICE:
When the measured value is greater than the specified value, retighten the clamp.
SST
G21595
27.
Hold
SST
Turn
G21592
INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT INBOARD JOINT BOOT
LH
NO.2 CLAMP
(a) Install the inboard joint boot LH No.2 clamp.
(b) Place SST onto the inboard joint boot LH No.2 clamp.
SST 09521-24010
(c) Tighten the SST so that the inboard joint boot LH No.2
clamp is pinched.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3064
30-51
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
REAR DRIVE SHAFT (4WD)
(1)
Using SST, measure the clearance of the inboard
joint boot LH No.2 clamp.
SST 09240-00020
Clearance: 1.1 mm (0.043 in.) or less
NOTICE:
When the measured value is greater than the specified value, retighten the clamp.
SST
G21596
28.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
INSPECT REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH
Check that there is no remarkable play in the radial direction of the outboard joint.
Check that the inboard joint slides smoothly in the thrust direction.
Check that there is no remarkable play in the radial direction of the inboard joint.
Check the boots for damage.
29. INSTALL REAR DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH
(a) Align the shaft splines and install the drive shaft assy with
a brass bar and a hammer.
NOTICE:
Set the snap ring with the opening side facing downward.
Be careful not to damage the oil seal boot and dust
cover.
Move the drive shaft assy while keeping it level.
F45240
30.
(a)
INSTALL REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH
Push the rear axle carrier sub-assy LH toward the inside of the vehicle fitting it to the splined part of
the rear drive shaft assy LH and insert.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the joint boot and speed sensor rotor.
31. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
32. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
33. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
34.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT
Install a new axle shaft LH nut.
Torque: 294 N⋅m, (3,000 kgf⋅cm, 217 ft⋅lbf)
Using a chisel and a hammer, stake the axle shaft LH nut.
C89301
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3065
30-52
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
REAR DRIVE SHAFT (4WD)
35.
(a)
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR LH
Install the speed sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the speed sensor.
Prevent foreign matter from adhering to the speed sensor.
Do not twist the sensor wire when installing the sensor.
36. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
37. STABILIZE SUSPENSION (SEE PAGE 27-29 )
38. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (SEE PAGE 27-25 )
39. FULLY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
40. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
41. INSPECT AND ADJUST REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
42. CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3066
30-12
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT
ASSY (4WD)
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (4WD)
300OG-01
OVERHAUL
HINT:
COMPONENTS:SEE PAGE 30-4
1.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY
2.
(a)
(b)
F40503
C23342
REMOVE PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT
ASSY
Depress the brake pedal and hold it.
Using a hexagon wrench (6 mm), loosen the cross groove
joint set bolts 1/2 turn.
HINT:
Put a piece of shop rag or equivalent into the inside of the universal joint cover so that the boot does not touch the inside of
the universal joint cover.
(c)
(d)
Place matchmarks on both the flanges.
Remove the 4 nuts, bolts and washers.
(e)
Remove the 4 bolts, 2 adjusting shims and propeller shaft
w/ center bearing shaft assy.
(f)
Insert SST in the transfer to prevent oil leakage.
SST 09325-20010
Matchmarks
F40504
C83005
SST
F40505
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3026
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
3.
(a)
(b)
-
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT
ASSY (4WD)
30-13
REMOVE PROPELLER SHAFT ASSY
Place matchmarks on both the flanges.
Remove the 4 nuts, bolts and washers.
Matchmarks
F40506
4.
REMOVE INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
(a) Place matchmarks on the joint and flange.
NOTICE:
Do not make matchmarks with a punch.
(b) Using a hexagon wrench (6 mm), remove the 6 bolts and
2 washers and separate the intermediate shaft from the
rear propeller shaft.
Matchmarks
F40507
5.
(a)
INSPECT SPIDER BEARING
Check the spider bearing axial play by turning the flange
while holding the shaft tightly.
HINT:
If necessary, replace the shaft.
Q07980
6.
(a)
INSPECT INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
Using a dial indicator, inspect the runout of the shaft.
Maximum runout: 0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
HINT:
If the shaft runout exceeds the maximum, replace the shaft.
C53258
(b)
Using a dial indicator, inspect the front side of the intermediate shaft flange runout.
Maximum runout: 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
HINT:
If the shaft runout exceeds the maximum, replace the shaft.
C53240
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3027
30-14
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
(c)
-
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT
ASSY (4WD)
Using a dial indicator, inspect the rear side of the intermediate shaft flange runout in the horizontal direction.
Maximum runout: 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
HINT:
If the intermediate shaft flange runout exceeds the maximum,
replace the intermediate shaft.
C53241
(d)
Using a dial indicator, inspect the rear side of the intermediate shaft flange runout in the vertical direction.
Maximum runout: 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
HINT:
If the intermediate shaft flange runout exceeds the maximum,
replace the intermediate shaft.
C53244
7.
(a)
INSPECT PROPELLER SHAFT ASSY
Using a dial indicator, inspect the runout of the propeller
shaft.
Maximum runout: 0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
HINT:
If the shaft runout exceeds the maximum, replace the propeller
shaft.
C36277
8.
(a)
SST
(b)
REMOVE CENTER SUPPORT BEARING ASSY NO.2
Using a chisel and a hammer, loosen the staked part of
the nut.
Using SST to hold the front flange, remove the nut and
plate washer.
SST 09330-00021
F40508
(c)
Matchmarks
Place matchmarks on the rear flange and shaft.
F40509
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3028
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
(d)
(e)
-
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT
ASSY (4WD)
30-15
Using SST, remove the rear flange.
SST 09950- 40011 (09951- 04020, 09952- 04010,
09953- 04030, 09954- 04010, 09955- 04061,
09957-04010, 09958-04011)
Remove the center support bearing assy No.2 and plate
washer.
SST
F40510
SST
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CENTER SUPPORT BEARING ASSY NO.1
Using a chisel and a hammer, loosen the staked part of
the nut.
Using SST to hold the front flange, remove the nut and
plate washer.
SST 09330-00021
F40511
Matchmarks
(c)
Place matchmarks on the front flange and shaft.
(d)
Using SST, remove the front flange.
SST 09950- 40011 (09951- 04020, 09952- 04010,
09953- 04030, 09954- 04010, 09955- 04061,
09957-04010, 09958-04011)
Remove the center support bearing assy No.1 and plate
washer.
F40512
SST
(e)
C23354
F40513
10.
(a)
C22188
INSPECT CENTER SUPPORT BEARING ASSY NO.2
Turn the bearing by hand with applying force in the rotation direction. Check the bearing turns smoothly.
Check that the seals are not cracked or damaged.
(b)
HINT:
If the bearing is damaged, worn, or does not turn freely, replace
it.
11. INSPECT CENTER SUPPORT BEARING ASSY NO.1
(a) Inspect the center support bearing assy No.1 by the same
procedures with center support bearing assy No.2.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3029
30-16
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
12.
(a)
-
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT
ASSY (4WD)
INSPECT PROPELLER SHAFT
Using a dial indicator, inspect the runout of the rear propeller shaft.
Maximum runout: 0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
HINT:
If the shaft runout exceeds the maximum, replace the rear propeller shaft.
C53259
13.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL CENTER SUPPORT BEARING ASSY NO.1
Set the center support bearing assy No.1 on the intermediate shaft, as shown in the illustration.
Install the plate washer to the intermediate shaft.
Front
F40522
Matchmarks
(c)
Align the matchmarks on the front flange and shaft and
place the flange on the shaft.
(d)
Using SST to hold the front flange, press the center support bearing assy No.1 into position by tightening down a
new nut and plate washer.
SST 09330-00021
Torque: 182 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
Loosen the nut.
Torque the nut again.
Torque: 69 N·m (700 kgf·cm, 51 ft·lbf)
Using a chisel and a hammer, stake the nut.
F40512
(e)
(f)
SST
F40523
(g)
14.
(a)
Rear
(b)
INSTALL CENTER SUPPORT BEARING ASSY NO.2
Set the center support bearing assy No.2 on the shaft as
shown in the illustration.
Install the plate washer to the shaft.
F40524
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3030
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
Matchmarks
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT
ASSY (4WD)
30-17
(c)
Align the matchmarks on the rear flange and shaft and
place the flange on the shaft.
(d)
Using SST to hold the front flange, press the center support bearing assy No.2 into position by tightening down a
new nut and plate washer.
SST 09330-00021
Torque: 182 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
Loosen the nut.
Torque the nut again.
Torque: 69 N·m (700 kgf·cm, 51 ft·lbf)
Using a chisel and a hammer, stake the nut.
F40509
SST
(e)
(f)
F40525
(g)
15.
(a)
(b)
Matchmarks
-
INSTALL INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
Align the matchmarks on the intermediate shaft and rear
propeller shaft, then install the 2 washers and 6 bolts.
Using a hexagon wrench (6 mm), tighten the 6 bolts temporarily.
F40507
16.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL PROPELLER SHAFT ASSY
Align the matchmarks on the propeller shaft flange and
differential companion flange, and connect the shaft with
the 4 bolts, washers and nuts.
Torque: 74 N·m (750 kgf·cm, 54 ft·lbf)
Check that the each joint of the propeller shaft is facing
to the direction, as shown in the illustration.
Matchmarks
F40506
C83556
F45568
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3031
30-18
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
17.
Matchmarks
-
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT
ASSY (4WD)
(a)
INSTALL PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT
ASSY
Align the matchmarks on the propeller shaft flange and
differential companion flange, and connect the shaft with
the 4 bolts, washers and nuts.
(b)
(c)
Remove SST from the transaxle.
Insert the yoke into the transaxle.
(d)
Install the 2 adjusting shims and propeller shaft w/ center
bearing, and temporarily tighten the 4 bolts.
(e)
Tighten the 4 nuts.
Torque: 74 N·m (750 kgf·cm, 54 ft·lbf)
18.
FULLY TIGHTEN PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING
SHAFT ASSY
Remove the shop rag to the joint.
Using a hexagon wrench (6 mm), tighten the 6 bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (296 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
F40504
SST
F40505
C83005
F40504
(a)
(b)
C23342
F40503
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3032
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
58.0 0.5 mm
(2.283 0.020 in.)
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT
ASSY (4WD)
30-19
(c)
With the vehicle unloaded, adjust the dimension between
the rear side of the cover and shaft, as shown in the illustration.
(d)
Under the same condition as (a), adjust the front and rear
dimensions between edge surface of the center support
bearing and the edge surface of the cushion to 12.5 1.0
mm (0.492 0.039 in.) respectively as shown, then
torque the bolts.
Torque: 37 N·m (375 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
Check that the center line of the bracket is at the right
angle in the shaft axial direction.
F40527
Front Center
Support Bearing
12.5 1.0 mm
(0.492 0.039 in.)
Rear Center
Support Bearing
-
(e)
(a)
12.5 1.0 mm
(0.492 0.039 in.)
(a)
F40528
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3033
30-20
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
(f)
-
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT
ASSY (4WD)
If any vibration or noise occurs, perform joint angle check
as follows and replace the adjusting shim with proper one.
(1) Turn the propeller shaft several times by hand to
stabilize the center support bearings.
(2) Using a jack, raise and lower the differential to stabilize the differential mounting cushion.
(3) Remove the transfer dynamic damper.
(4) Using SST, measure the installation angle of the
transfer (A) and front propeller shaft (B).
SST 09370-50010
No.1 joint angle: A - B = -1.6 to -3.6
(5) Using SST, measure the installation angle of the
rear propeller shaft (C) and rear differential (D).
SST 09370-50010
No.2 joint angle: C - D = 2.1 to 4.1
No.1 Joint Angle
A - B = -1.6 to -3.6
No.2 Joint Angle
C - D = 2.1 to 4.1
B
A
D
C
SST
SST
F40924
HINT:
If the measured angle is not within the specification, adjust it
with the center support bearing adjusting shim.
Center support bearing adjusting shim thickness:
Thickness mm (in.)
(g)
19.
20.
21.
Thickness mm (in.)
3.2 (0.126)
11.0 (0.433)
4.5 (0.177)
13.5 (0.531)
6.5 (0.256)
15.5 (0.610)
9.0 (0.354)
17.5 (0.689)
Install the transfer dynamic damper.
Torque: 26 N·m (260 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
INSPECT AND ADJUST TRANSFER OIL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3034
30-38
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
300OI-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: SEE PAGE 30-4
Replace the RH side by the same procedures with LH side.
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
(a)
SST
(b)
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
Using SST and a hammer, unstake the staked part of the
lock nut.
SST 09930-00010
While applying the brakes, remove the lock nut.
F40146
3.
(a)
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
Remove the bolt, separate the sensor wire and flexible
hose from the shock absorber.
(b)
Remove the bolt and separate the speed sensor from the
steering knuckle.
4.
(a)
SEPARATE FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Remove the 2 bolts, separate the brake caliper.
F40138
F40147
F40167
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3052
30-39
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
5.
-
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
REMOVE FRONT DISC
6.
(a)
(b)
SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the cotter pin and nut.
Using SST, separate the tie rod end from the steering
knuckle.
SST 09628-6201 1
7.
SEPARATE FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY
LOWER NO.1 LH
Remove the bolt and 2 nuts, and separate the lower suspension arm from the lower ball joint.
SST
F40145
(a)
F40142
Matchmarks
8.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT AXLE ASSY LH
Put matchmarks on the drive shaft and the axle hub.
Using a plastic hammer, separate the drive shaft from the
axle hub.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the boot and speed sensor rotor.
D32030
(c)
9.
(a)
Remove the 2 bolts, nuts and steering knuckle with the
axle hub.
REMOVE LOWER BALL JOINT ASSY FRONT LH
Remove the cotter pin and nut.
C83023
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3053
30-40
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
(b)
Using SST, remove the ball joint.
SST 09628-6201 1
10.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL BEARING
DEFLECTOR NO.1 LH
Using a screwdriver, remove the dust deflector.
11.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB LH HOLE SNAP RING
Using a snap ring plier, remove the snap ring.
12.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
Using SST, remove the axle hub.
(b)
Using SST and a press, remove the inner race (outside)
from the axle hub.
SST 09520- 00031, 09950- 00020, 09950- 60010
(09951-00430), 09950-70010 (09951-07100)
REMOVE DISC BRAKE DUST COVER FRONT LH
Using a torx wrench (T30), remove the 4 bolts and dust
cover.
SST
F40153
DUST
F40154
F40155
SST
F40156
SST
13.
(a)
F02261
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3054
30-41
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
14.
(a)
(b)
SST
-
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB LH BEARING
Place the inner race (outside) on the bearing.
Using SST and a press, press the bearing until it contacts
with the SST.
SST
F40230
(c)
Using a spanner to make the steering knuckle horizontal,
fix it to the V block as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Be sure the steering knuckle is horizontally positioned.
(d) Using SST and a press, remove the bearing.
SST 09527- 17011, 09950- 60020 (09951- 00750),
09950-70010 (09951-07100)
SST
F11547
15.
(a)
SST
16.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH BEARING
Using SST and a press, install a new bearing to the steering knuckle.
SST 09608- 32010, 09950- 60020 (09951- 00810),
09950-70010 (09951-07100)
INSTALL DISC BRAKE DUST COVER FRONT LH
Place the dust cover and using a torx wrench (T30),
torque the 4 bolts.
F40231
SST
17.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
Using SST and a press, install the axle hub.
SST 09608- 32010, 09950- 60020 (09951- 00810),
09950-70010 (09951-07100)
18.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH HOLE SNAP RING
Using snap ring pliers, install a new snap ring.
F40157
F40155
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3055
30-42
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
19.
(a)
SST
-
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL BEARING DUST
DEFLECTOR NO.1 LH
Using SST and a hammer, install a new dust deflector.
SST 09316- 60011 (09316- 00011, 09316- 00031),
09608-32010
HINT:
Align the holes for the ABS speed sensor in the dust deflector
with steering knuckle.
F02216
20.
(a)
INSTALL LOWER BALL JOINT ASSY FRONT LH
Install the lower ball joint and tighten the nut.
Torque: 123 N⋅m (1,250 kgf⋅cm, 90 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
If the holes for the cotter pin are not aligned, tighten the nut further up to 60.
21. INSTALL FRONT AXLE ASSY LH
(a) Align the matchmarks and install the drive shaft assy LH
Matchmarks
to the front axle assy LH.
D32030
F47689
(b)
22.
(a)
23.
(a)
(b)
24.
Install the 2 bolts, nuts and axle assembly to the shock absorber.
Torque: 230 N⋅m (2,345 kgf⋅cm, 170 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Insert the bolt from the front side of the vehicle and tighten the
nut.
(c) Push the front axle assy toward the outside of the vehicle,
fit the spline part of the drive shaft assy to that of the front
axle assy and insert the drive shaft assy into the front axle
C83023
assy.
NOTICE:
Do not push out the front axle assy excessively.
Be careful not to damage the drive shaft outboard
joint boot.
Be careful not to damage the speed sensor rotor.
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY LOWER NO.1 LH
Connect the lower arm and ball joint with the 2 nuts and bolt.
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY LH
Connect the tie rod end to the steering knuckle.
Install the nut and a new cotter pin.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL FRONT DISC
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3056
30-43
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
25.
(a)
26.
-
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSY LH
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Install the brake caliper assembly with the 2 bolts to the
steering knuckle.
Torque: 107 N⋅m (1,090 kgf⋅cm, 79 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
F40167
27.
28.
SEPARATE FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
REMOVE FRONT DISC
29.
(a)
INSPECT BEARING BACKLASH
Using a dial indicator, check the backlash near the center
of the axle hub.
Maximum: 0 mm (0 in.)
If the backlash exceeds the maximum, replace the bearing.
F40163
30.
(a)
INSPECT AXLE HUB DEVIATION
Using a dial indicator, check the deviation at the surface
of the axle hub outside the hub bolt.
Maximum: 0.07 mm (0.0027 in.)
If the backlash exceeds the maximum, replace the axle hub.
31. INSTALL FRONT DISC
F40164
32.
(a)
33.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Install the brake caliper assy with the 2 bolts to the steering knuckle.
Torque: 107 N⋅m (1,090 kgf⋅cm, 79 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
F40167
34.
35.
36.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 26-7 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3057
30-44
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT AXLE LH HUB BOLT
FRONT AXLE LH HUB BOLT
300OJ-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS:SEE PAGE 30-4
Replace the RH side by the same procedures with LH side.
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY
LH(SEE PAGE 30-38 )
3.
REMOVE FRONT DISC
4.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT AXLE LH HUB BOLT
Using SST and a screwdriver or an equivalent to hold, remove the hub bolt.
SST 09628-1001 1
5.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT AXLE LH HUB BOLT
Install a washer and nut to a new hub bolt as shown in the
illustration.
Using a screwdriver to hold, install the hub bolt by torquing the nut.
INSTALL FRONT DISC
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
(SEE PAGE 30-38 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
SST
F40170
(b)
6.
7.
F40171
8.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3058
30-58
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH (FF)
REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH (FF)
300OM-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: SEE PAGE 30-4
Replace the RH side by the same procedures with the LH side.
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
3.
REMOVE REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 32-29 )
4.
DISCONNECT SKID CONTROL SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
5.
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH
6.
SEPARATE STRUT ROD ASSY REAR
7.
(a)
SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH
Remove the bolt, nut and rear suspension arm No. 2 from
the rear axle carrier.
HINT:
While fixing the nut, turn and remove the bolt.
C83017
8.
(a)
SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH
Remove the bolt, nut and rear suspension arm No. 1 from
the rear axle carrier.
HINT:
While fixing the nut, turn and remove the bolt.
C83018
9.
(a)
REMOVE REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the 2 bolts, nuts and rear axle carrier from the
shock absorber.
C83019
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3072
30-59
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
10.
(a)
-
REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH (FF)
INSTALL REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH
Install the rear axle carrier with the 2 bolts and nuts.
Torque: 180 N⋅m (1,840 kgf⋅cm, 133 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Insert the bolt from the rear side of the vehicle and install the
nut.
C83019
11.
(a)
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM
ASSY NO.1 LH
Install the rear suspension arm No. 1 to the rear axle carrier with the bolt and nut, temporarily tighten the bolt.
HINT:
Insert the bolt from the front side of the vehicle and while fixing
the nut, turn and install the bolt.
C83018
12.
(a)
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM
ASSY NO.2 LH
Install the rear suspension arm No. 2 to the rear axle carrier with the bolt and nut, temporarily tighten the bolt.
HINT:
Insert the bolt from the rear side of the vehicle and while fixing
the nut, turn and install the bolt.
C83017
13. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
14. INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-53 )
15. INSPECT BEARING BACKLASH (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
16. INSPECT AXLE HUB DEVIATION (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
17. CONNECT SKID CONTROL SENSOR
(a) Connect the connector.
NOTICE:
Do not twist the sensor wire when connecting it.
18. INSTALL REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 32-29 )
19. INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-53 )
20. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
21. STABILIZE SUSPENSION (SEE PAGE 27-27 )
22. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 27-16 )
23. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (SEE PAGE 27-23 )
24. FULLY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
25. INSPECT AND ADJUST REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
26. CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3073
30-64
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
REAR AXLE LH HUB BOLT
REAR AXLE LH HUB BOLT
300OP-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS:SEE PAGE 30-4
Replace the RH side by the same procedures with the LH side.
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
(2WD DRIVE TYPE)
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and brake caliper.
(b) Support the brake caliper securely.
3.
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
(4WD DRIVE TYPE)
4.
REMOVE REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 32-29 )
SST
5.
(a)
REMOVE REAR AXLE LH HUB BOLT
Using SST and a screwdriver or an equivalent to hold, remove the hub bolt.
SST 09628-1001 1
6.
(a)
INSTALL REAR AXLE LH HUB BOLT
Install a washer and nut to a new hub bolt as shown in the
illustration.
Using a screwdriver to hold, install the hub bolt by torquing the nut.
INSTALL REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 32-29 )
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
(2WD DRIVE TYPE)
Install the brake caliper with the 2 bolts.
Torque:
2WD: 61.8 N⋅m (630 kgf⋅cm, 46 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
(4WD DRIVE TYPE)
Install the brake caliper with the 2 bolts.
Torque:
4WD: 58 N⋅m (592 kgf⋅cm, 43 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
C83020
(b)
7.
8.
C83021
(a)
9.
(a)
10.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3078
30-21
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
300OH-02
OVERHAUL
HINT:
COMPONENTS: SEE PAGE 30-4
Overhaul the RH side following the same procedures as for the LH side.
1.
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
2.
DRAIN TRANSFER OIL (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
HINT:
Perform the procedure only when removing the RH side.
3.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
4.
(a)
SST
F40146
Hold
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
Using SST and a hammer, unstake the staked part of the
axle hub LH nut.
SST 09930-00010
NOTICE:
Loosen the staked part of the nut completely, otherwise the
screw of the drive shaft may be damaged.
(b) While applying the brakes, remove the lock axle hub LH
nut.
5.
SEPARATE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
(a) Remove the nut, and separate the stabilizer link assy LH.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon
wrench (6 mm) to hold the stud.
Turn
F40136
6.
(a)
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
Remove the bolt and clip, and separate the sensor wire
and hose from the shock absorber.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the speed sensor.
C83022
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3035
30-22
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
(b)
Remove the bolt, and separate the speed sensor front LH
from the steering knuckle.
NOTICE:
Prevent foreign matter from adhering to the speed sensor.
F40147
Hold
7.
(a)
(b)
SEPARATE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the cotter pin and nut.
Using SST, separate the tie rod end from the steering
knuckle.
SST 09628-6201 1
8.
SEPARATE FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSY
LOWER NO.1 LH
Remove the bolt and 2 nuts, and separate the front suspension arm sub-assy lower No.1 LH from the lower ball
joint.
Turn
D27487
SST
F45060
(a)
F40142
Matchmarks
9.
(a)
(b)
SEPARATE FRONT AXLE ASSY LH
Put matchmarks on the drive shaft and the axle hub.
Using a plastic hammer, separate the drive shaft from the
axle hub.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the boot and speed sensor rotor.
D32030
10.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH
Using SST, remove the front drive shaft assy LH.
SST 09520-01010, 09520-24010 (09520-32040)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the transaxle case oil seal,
inboard joint boot and drive shaft dust cover.
Be careful not to drop the drive shaft assy.
SST
F40148
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3036
30-23
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
11.
(a)
(b)
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (3MZ-FE
for 2WD DRIVE TYPE)
Using a screwdriver, remove the bearing bracket hole
snap ring.
Remove the bolt and front drive shaft assy RH from the
drive shaft bearing bracket.
C80304
12.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (2AZ-FE for
2WD DRIVE TYPE)
Remove the 2 bolts and pull out the drive shaft together
with the center bearing bracket.
Remove the drive shaft assy RH.
F44774
13.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (RH for 4WD DRIVE TYPE)
SST 09520-01010, 09520-24010 (09520-32040)
HINT:
Overhaul the RH side following the same procedures as for the LH side.
NOTICE:
When removing and installing the front drive shaft assy RH in a 4WD vehicle, be sure to first
drain all the transaxle oil and transfer oil. If removal and installation is carried out without draining these oils, the transfer oil will flow into the transaxle side. Extensive cleaning will be required if the two oils mix.
Do not damage the oil seal and dust cover.
Move the drive shaft assy while keeping it level.
14.
FIX FRONT AXLE ASSY LH
SST 09608-16042 (09608-02021, 09608-02041)
NOTICE:
The hub bearing could be damaged if it is subjected to the
vehicle’s full weight, such as when moving the vehicle with
the drive shaft removed.
Therefore, if it is absolutely necessary to place the vehicle
weight on the hub bearing, first support it with SST.
SST
C54583
F45045
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3037
30-24
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
15.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
INSPECT FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH
Check that there is no remarkable play in the radial direction of the outboard joint.
Check that the inboard joint slides smoothly in the thrust
direction.
Check that there is no remarkable play in the radial direction of the inboard joint.
Check the boots for damage.
C91598
16.
Omega Type:
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT LH
NO.2 CLAMP
Omega Type:
Using pliers, remove the inboard joint boot LH No.2
clamp, as shown in the illustration.
Claw Engagement Type:
Using pliers, remove the inboard joint boot LH No.2
clamp, as shown in the illustration.
Claw Engagement Type:
C86265
F07391
F45953
(c)
One Touch Type:
17.
(a)
One Touch Type:
Using a screwdriver, remove the inboard joint boot LH
No.2 clamp, as shown in the illustration.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT LH
CLAMP
Remove the inboard joint boot LH clamp using the same
procedures as for the inboard joint boot LH No.2 clamp.
C67412
18.
(a)
SEPARATE FR AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT
Separate the inboard joint boot from the inboard joint assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3038
30-25
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
19.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE INBOARD JOINT ASSY LH
Put matchmarks on the inboard joint assy and outboard
joint shaft.
NOTICE:
Do not use a punch for the marks.
(b) Remove the inboard joint assy from the outboard joint
shaft.
Matchmarks
C67413
-
F45461
(c)
Using a snap ring expander, remove the shaft snap ring.
F45046
C67414
(d)
Put matchmarks on the outboard joint shaft and tripod
joint.
NOTICE:
Do not use a punch for the marks.
(e) Using a brass bar and hammer, remove the tripod joint
from the outboard joint shaft.
NOTICE:
Do not tap the roller.
Matchmarks
N00194
20. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DAMPER LH
HINT:
This procedure is unnecessary for a 3MZ-FE 4WD drive type
vehicle (Front drive shaft RH) because it dose not have a drive
shaft damper.
(a) Omega Type:
Using pliers, remove the drive shaft damper clamp, as
shown in the illustration.
Omega Type:
F46963
(b)
Claw Engagement Type:
Claw Engagement:
Using needle-nose pliers, remove the drive shaft damper
clamp, as shown in the illustration.
F46964
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3039
30-26
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
(c)
One Touch Type:
(d)
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
One Touch Type:
Using a screwdriver, remove the drive shaft damper
clamp, as shown in the illustration.
Remove the drive shaft damper.
D31926
21.
Omega Type:
(a)
REMOVE FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT LH
NO.2 CLAMP
Omega Type:
Using pliers, remove the outboard joint boot LH No.2
clamp, as shown in the illustration.
C81167
(b)
One Touch Type:
22.
(a)
One Touch Type:
Using a screwdriver, remove the outboard joint boot LH
No.2 clamp, as shown in the illustration.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT LH
CLAMP
Remove the outboard joint boot LH clamp using the same
procedures as for the outboard joint boot LH No.2 clamp.
C97385
23.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
Remove the outboard joint boot from the outboard joint shaft.
Remove the old grease from the outboard joint.
24.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE INNER SHAFT INNER LH
SHAFT SNAP RING
Using a screwdriver, remove the hole snap ring.
C57543
25.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE INNER SHAFT INNER RH SHAFT SNAP RING (RH for 4WD DRIVE TYPE)
Using a screwdriver, remove the hole snap ring.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3040
30-27
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
26.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER LH
Using SST and a press, remove the drive shaft dust cover
LH.
SST 09950-00020
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the inboard joint assy.
SST
F40647
27.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER RH (RH
for 2WD DRIVE TYPE)
Using a press, remove the drive shaft dust cover RH.
C67101
28.
SST
(a)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER RH (RH
for 4WD DRIVE TYPE)
Using SST and a press, remove the drive shaft dust cover
RH.
SST 09950-00020
F40648
29.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER (RH for
2WD DRIVE TYPE)
Using SST and a press, remove the drive shaft dust cover.
SST 09950-00020
SST
C68342
F40208
30.
(a)
REMOVE CASE SUB ASSY, DRIVE SHAFT BEARING
SNAP RING (2AZ-FE for 2WD DRIVE TYPE)
Using a screwdriver, remove the bearing case snap ring.
C68337
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3041
30-28
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
31.
REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT BEARING CASE SUB ASSY
(2AZ-FE for 2WD DRIVE TYPE)
(a) Using a press, remove the bearing case snap ring.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the inboard joint assy.
C68338
32.
(a)
C53236
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT BEARING (RH for
2WD DRIVE TYPE)
Using a snap ring expander, remove the drive shaft hole
snap ring.
F40209
(b)
Using SST and a press, remove the bearing.
SST 09527-1001 1
(c) Remove the bearing bracket hole snap ring.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the inboard joint assy.
C68339
SST
F40210
33.
Steel Plate
SST
D27495
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT BEARING (3MZ-FE
for 2WD DRIVE TYPE)
(a) Install a new bearing bracket hole snap ring to the front
driver shaft assy RH.
(b) Using SST and a steel plate, install a new front drive shaft
bearing.
SST 09710-30021 (09710-03141)
NOTICE:
Bearing should be completely installed.
(c)
Using a snap ring expander, install a new drive shaft hole
snap ring.
D27493
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3042
30-29
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
34.
SST
C91253
27.1 0.3 mm
(1.067 0.012 in.)
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER
(3MZ-FE for 2WD DRIVE TYPE)
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new drive shaft dust cover.
SST 09726-40010, 09527-10011
NOTICE:
Dust cover should be completely installed.
Be careful not to damage the dust cover.
F45047
35.
SST
C68340
(a)
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT BEARING (2AZ-FE
for 2WD DRIVE TYPE)
Using SST and a press, install a new drive shaft bearing.
SST 09950- 60020 (09951- 00710), 09950- 70010
(09951-07100)
F40211
36.
(a)
INSTALL CASE SUB ASSY, DRIVE SHAFT BEARING
SNAP RING (2AZ-FE for 2WD DRIVE TYPE)
Using a screwdriver, install a new bearing case snap ring.
C68341
37.
INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT BEARING CASE SUB ASSY
(2AZ-FE for 2WD DRIVE TYPE)
(a) Using SST and a press, install the drive shaft bearing
case to the inboard joint assy RH.
SST 09527-1001 1, 09710-04081
NOTICE:
Bearing should be installed completely.
SST
C52593
F40212
(b)
C68582
Using a snap ring expander, install a new drive shaft hole
snap ring.
F40213
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3043
30-30
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
38.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER
(2AZ-FE for 2WD DRIVE TYPE)
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new driver shaft dust cover.
SST 09726-40010, 09527-10011
Distance (A): 0.5 0.5 mm (0.020 0.020 in.)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the dust cover.
(A)
SST
F40214
39.
SST
(a)
(A)
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER RH (RH
for 2WD DRIVE TYPE)
Using SST and a press, install a new drive shaft dust cover RH until the distance from the tip of the center drive
shaft to the drive shaft dust cover RH meets the specification, as shown in the illustration.
SST 09527-1001 1
Type
F02277
Distance (A)
2AZ-FE
91.5 mm (3.602 in.)
3MZ-FE
110.5 mm (4.350 in.)
NOTICE:
Dust cover should be completely installed.
Be careful not to damage the dust cover.
40.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER RH (RH
for 4WD DRIVE TYPE)
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new drive shaft dust cover RH.
SST 09527-1001 1
NOTICE:
Dust cover should be completely installed.
Be careful not to damage the dust cover.
SST
C68948
F40215
41.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER LH
Using SST and a press, install a new drive shaft dust cover LH.
SST 09527-1001 1
NOTICE:
Dust cover should be completely installed.
Be careful not to damage the dust cover.
SST
F41033
42.
(a)
43.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE INNER SHAFT INNER LH SHAFT SNAP RING
Install a new hole snap ring.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE INNER SHAFT INNER RH SHAFT SNAP RING (RH for 4WD DRIVE TYPE)
Install a new hole snap ring.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3044
30-31
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
W01994
Type
Grease capacity g (oz.)
3MZ-FE (FF)
205 to 225 g (7.3 to 8.0 oz.)
EXCEPT
3MZ-FE (FF)
190 to 200 g (6.7 to 7.0 oz.)
45.
Hold
SST
Turn
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
44. INSTALL OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
HINT:
Before installing the boots, wrap the spline of the drive shaft
with vinyl tape to prevent the boots from being damaged.
(a) Hold the drive shaft lightly in a soft vise.
(b) Temporarily install a new outboard joint boot with 2
clamps to the drive shaft.
(c) Pack the outboard joint shaft and boot with grease.
Vinyl Tape
Omega Type:
-
R10425
SST
R10426
INSTALL FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT LH
NO.2 CLAMP
(a) Omega Type:
Secure the 2 outboard joint boot clamps onto the boot.
(b) Place SST onto the outboard joint boot LH No.2 clamp.
SST 09521-24010
(c) Tighten the SST so that the outboard joint boot LH No.2
clamp is pinched.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
(d) Using SST, measure the clearance of the outboard joint
boot LH No.2 clamp.
SST 09240-00020
Clearance: 0.8 mm (0.031 in.) or less
NOTICE:
When the measured value is greater than the specified value, retighten the clamp.
46. INSTALL FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT LH
CLAMP
(a) The procedure for the outboard joint boot LH clamp is the
same as above.
SST 09521-24010, 09240-00020
47.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(A)
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DAMPER LH
Install the drive shaft damper LH to the drive shaft.
Make sure that the damper is on the shaft groove.
Set the distance, as described below.
Type
Distance (A)
3MZ-FE (FF)
227.5 2.0 mm (8.957 0.079 in.)
EXCEPT
3MZ-FE (FF)
225.4 2.0 mm (8.874 0.079 in.)
G31217
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3045
30-32
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
Omega Type:
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
48.
(a)
Hold
SST
Turn
-
D31927
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DAMPER RH CLAMP
Omega Type:
Hold the front drive shaft lightly in a soft vise.
(b) Install the drive shaft damper clamp to the damper.
NOTICE:
Be sure to install the clamp in the correct position.
(c) Place SST onto the drive shaft damper clamp.
SST 09521-24010
(d) Tighten the SST so that the clamp is pinched.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
(e)
SST
D31928
One Touch Type:
Using SST, measure the clearance of the drive shaft
damper clamp.
SST 09240-00020
Clearance: 0.8 mm (0.031 in.) or less
NOTICE:
When the measured value is greater than the specified value, retighten the clamp.
HINT:
This procedure is unnecessary for a 3MZ-FE 4WD drive type
vehicle (Front drive shaft RH) because it dose not have a drive
shaft damper.
(f)
One Touch Type:
Set a new damper clamp to the drive shaft damper RH
and install the damper clamp with a screwdriver.
(g)
Claw Engagement Type:
Set a new damper clamp to the drive shaft damper RH
and install the damper clamp with needle-nose pliers.
F47132
Claw Engagement Type:
F47133
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3046
30-33
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
49.
(a)
Matchmarks
C67417
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE INBOARD JOINT ASSY LH
Temporarily install a new inboard joint boot with 2 clamps
to the drive shaft.
(b) Place the beveled side of the tripod joint axial spline toward the outboard joint shaft.
(c) Align the matchmarks.
(d) Using a brass bar and hammer, tap in the tripod joint to the
outboard joint shaft.
NOTICE:
Do not tap the roller.
Be sure to install the tripod joint assy in the correct
direction.
(e)
(f)
C67414
Using a snap ring expander, install a new shaft snap ring.
Pack the outboard joint shaft and boot with grease.
Type
Grease capacity g (oz.)
3MZ-FE (FF)
155 to 175 g (5.6 to 6.2 oz.)
EXCEPT
3MZ-FE (FF)
175 to 185 g (6.2 to 6.5 oz.)
F45046
(g)
Matchmarks
Align the matchmarks, install the inboard joint assy to the
outboard joint shaft assy.
F40222
50.
(a)
INSTALL FR AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT
Install the inboard joint boot to the inboard joint assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3047
30-34
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
51.
Omega Type:
SST
C86269
INSTALL FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT LH
CLAMP
(a) Omega Type:
Install new inboard joint boot clamps.
(1) Hold the drive shaft lightly in a soft vise.
(2) Install 2 new inboard joint boot clamps to the boot.
(3) Place SST onto the inboard joint boot LH No.2
clamp.
SST 09521-24010
(4) Tighten the SST so that the inboard joint boot LH
No.2 clamp is pinched.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
(5)
Using SST, measure the clearance of the inboard
joint boot LH No.2 clamp.
SST 09240-00020
Clearance: 0.8 mm (0.031 in.) or less
NOTICE:
When the measured value is greater than the specified value, retighten the clamp.
SST
C86270
Claw Engagement Type:
(b)
Claw Engagement Type:
Using pliers, install the inboard joint boot LH No.2 clamp,
as shown in the illustration.
(c)
One Touch Type:
Using a screwdriver, install the inboard joint boot LH No.2
clamp, as shown in the illustration.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT LH
CLAMP
Install the inboard joint boot LH clamp using the same procedures as for the inboard joint boot LH No.2 clamp.
SST 09521-24010, 09240-00020
F07391
52.
One Touch
Type:
(a)
C81794
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3048
30-35
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
53.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
INSPECT FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
Check that there is no remarkable play in the radial direction of the outboard joint.
Check that the inboard joint slides smoothly in the thrust
direction.
Check that there is no remarkable play in the radial direction of the inboard joint.
Check the boots for damage.
C91598
HINT:
For dimension (A), refer to the following table.
(A)
C81796
DRIVE TYPE
LH mm (in.)
RH mm (in.)
2WD
2AZ-FE: 591.2 (23.27)
2.0 (0.08)
3MZ-FE: 579.4 (22.81)
2.0 (0.08)
2AZ-FE: 890.0 (35.03)
2.0 (0.08)
3MZ-FE: 898.0 (35.35)
2.0 (0.08)
4WD
556.5 (21.90)
2.0 (0.08)
932.5 (36.71)
2.0 (0.08)
F45048
54.
(a)
(b)
C83851
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH
Coat the spline of the inboard joint shaft assy with ATF.
Align the shaft splines and install the drive shaft assy with
a brass bar and a hammer.
NOTICE:
Set the snap ring with the opening side facing downward.
Be careful not to damage the oil seal boot and dust
cover.
Move the drive shaft assy while keeping it level.
55. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (3MZ-FE for
2WD DRIVE TYPE)
(a) Using a screwdriver, install a new bearing bracket hole
snap ring.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the oil seal and boot.
(b) Install the bolt.
Torque: 32 N⋅m (330 kgf⋅cm, 24 ft⋅lbf)
C80304
56.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (2AZ-FE for
2WD DRIVE TYPE)
(a) Coat the spline of the inboard joint shaft assy RH with
gear oil.
(b) Align the shaft splines and install the drive shaft assy RH
with the 2 bolts.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the oil seal, boot and dust cover.
F44774
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3049
30-36
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
57. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (RH for 4WD DRIVE TYPE)
HINT:
Install the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
NOTICE:
Set the snap ring with the opening side facing downward.
Be careful not to damage the transaxle case oil seal, inboard joint boot and drive shaft dust cover.
58.
(a)
Matchmarks
D32030
INSTALL FRONT AXLE ASSY LH
Align the matchmarks and install the drive shaft assy LH
to the front axle assy LH.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the outboard joint boot.
Be careful not to damage the speed sensor rotor.
F47689
59.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB- ASSY
LOWER NO.1 LH
Install the lower ball joint to the front suspension arm subassy lower with the bolt and nuts.
Torque: 127 N⋅m (1,300 kgf⋅cm, 94 ft⋅lbf)
F40142
60.
(a)
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSY LH
Install the tie rod end to the steering knuckle with the nut.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
NOTICE:
If the holes for the cotter pin are not aligned, tighten the nut up to 60 further.
61.
(a)
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
Install the speed sensor to the steering knuckle with the
bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Prevent foreign matter from adhering to the speed sensor.
F40147
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3050
30-37
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
(b)
C83022
Hold
Turn
Install the flexible hose and the speed sensor to the shock
absorber with the bolt and set the clip of the sensor on the
knuckle.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (192 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the speed sensor.
Prevent foreign matter from adhering to the speed
sensor.
Do not twist the sensor wire when installing the speed
sensor.
62. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH
(a) Install the stabilizer link assy LH with the nut.
Torque: 74 N⋅m (755 kgf⋅cm, 55 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon (6 mm)
wrench to hold the stud.
F40136
63.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
Using a socket wrench (30 mm), install a new axle hub LH
nut.
Torque: 294 N⋅m (3,000 kgf⋅cm, 217 ft⋅lbf)
Using a chisel and a hammer, stake the axle hub LH nut.
C68609
64.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
ADD TRANSFER OIL (4WD DRIVE TYPE)
65.
66.
67.
HINT:
Perform the procedure only when installing the RH side.
68. INSPECT TRANSFER OIL (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 31-4 )
HINT:
Perform the procedure only when installing the RH side.
69. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 26-7 )
70. CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3051
30-60
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH (4WD)
REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH (4WD)
300OO-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: SEE PAGE 30-4
Replace the RH side using the same procedures as for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR REAR LH
(a) Remove the bolt and separate the speed sensor from the axle carrier.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the speed sensor.
Prevent foreign matter from adhering to the speed sensor.
3.
(a)
SST
C89299
F45516
REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT
Using SST and a hammer, unstake the staked part of the
axle hub LH nut.
SST 09930-00010
NOTICE:
Loosen the staked part of the nut completely, otherwise the
screw of the drive shaft may be damaged.
(b) While applying the brakes, remove the lock axle hub LH
nut.
4.
(a)
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Remove the bolt, and separate the flexible hose from the
shock absorber.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and separate rear disc brake caliper
assy.
NOTICE:
Use a string or other device to keep the brake caliper from
hanging down.
G24026
5.
REMOVE REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 32-29 )
6.
(a)
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH
Remove the 4 bolts and the rear axle hub & bearing assy
LH.
G32185
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3074
30-61
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH (4WD)
7.
(a)
SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH
Using a jack, raise the rear axle carrier sub-assy LH, as
shown in the illustration.
(b)
Remove the bolt and nut, and separate the rear suspension arm assy No.1 LH (rear axle carrier side) from the
rear axle carrier.
G31901
HINT:
When removing the bolt, keep the nut from rotating.
G31902
8.
(a)
SEPARATE STRUT ROD ASSY REAR
Remove the bolt and nut, and separate the strut rod assy
rear (rear axle carrier side) from the rear axle carrier.
HINT:
When removing the bolt, keep the nut from rotating.
G31903
9.
(a)
SEPARATE REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH
Remove the bolt and nut, and separate the rear suspension arm assy No.2 LH (rear axle carrier side) from the
rear axle carrier.
HINT:
When removing the bolt, keep the nut from rotating.
G31904
10.
(a)
REMOVE REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts, and the rear axle carrier
sub-assy LH from the shock absorber.
G24032
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3075
30-62
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
11.
(a)
-
REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH (4WD)
INSTALL REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH
Install the rear axle carrier sub-assy LH with the 2 bolts
and nuts.
Torque: 180 N⋅m (1,840 kgf⋅cm, 133 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Insert the bolt from the rear side of the vehicle and temporarily
install the nut to the shock absorber.
G24032
12.
(a)
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM
ASSY NO.2 LH
Temporarily tighten the rear suspension arm assy No.2
LH with the bolt and nut.
HINT:
Insert the bolt from the rear side of the vehicle and lightly tighten
the bolt.
G31904
13.
(a)
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR
Temporarily tighten the strut rod assy rear with the bolt
and nut.
HINT:
Insert the bolt from the inside of the vehicle and lightly tighten
the bolt.
G31903
14.
(a)
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM
ASSY NO.1 LH
Temporarily tighten the rear suspension arm assy No.1
LH with the bolt and nut.
HINT:
Insert the bolt from the front side of the vehicle and lightly tighten the bolt.
G31902
15.
(a)
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH
Install the rear axle hub & bearing assy LH with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 75 N⋅m (765 kgf⋅cm, 55 ft⋅lbf)
G32185
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3076
30-63
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
16.
17.
18.
-
REAR AXLE CARRIER SUB-ASSY LH (4WD)
INSPECT BEARING BACKLASH (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
INSPECT AXLE HUB DEVIATION (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
INSTALL REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 32-29 )
19.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Install the rear disc brake caliper assy LH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 78 N⋅m (800 kgf⋅cm, 58 ft⋅lbf)
Install the flexible hose with the bolt to the shock absorber.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (192 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
G24026
20.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT
Install a new axle shaft LH nut.
Torque: 294 N⋅m, (3,000 kgf⋅cm, 217 ft⋅lbf)
Using a chisel and a hammer, stake the axle shaft LH nut.
C89301
21.
(a)
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR LH
Install the speed sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the speed sensor.
Prevent foreign matter from adhering to the speed sensor.
Do not twist the sensor wire when installing the sensor.
22. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
23. STABILIZE SUSPENSION (SEE PAGE 27-29 )
24. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.2 LH (SEE PAGE 27-25 )
25. FULLY TIGHTEN STRUT ROD ASSY REAR (SEE PAGE 27-13 )
26. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SUSPENSION ARM ASSY NO.1 LH (SEE PAGE 27-18 )
27. INSPECT AND ADJUST REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
28. CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3077
30-4
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT / AXLE
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT / AXLE
300OF-01
COMPONENTS
Propeller Shaft Assy
Adjusting Shim
Center Support
Bearing Assy No.1
1st: 182 (1,850, 134)
2nd: 69 (700, 51)
Adjusting Shim
74 (750, 54)
Intermediate Shaft
Plate Washer
Rear Flange
Front
Flange
Washer
Center Support
Bearing Assy No.1
37 (375, 27)
Plate Washer
37 (375, 27)
74 (750, 54)
1st: 182 (1,850, 134)
2nd: 69 (700, 51)
Washer
74 (750, 54)
29 (296, 21)
Propeller Shaft
Assy Rear
74 (750, 54)
Washer
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
29 (296, 21)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
G25996
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3018
30-5
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
Front Drive Shaft Assy RH
(3MZ-FE: 4WD)
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT / AXLE
Front Drive Shaft Assy RH
(2AZ-FE: 4WD)
Front Drive Shaft RH Hole Snap Ring
Front Drive Shaft Assy RH
(2AZ-FE: 2WD)
Front Drive Shaft Assy RH
(3MZ-FE: 2WD)
74 (755, 55)
74 (755, 55)
Bearing Bracket Hole Snap Ring
Front Drive Shaft LH Hole Snap Ring
32 (330, 24)
Front Drive Shaft Assy LH
Front Stabilizer
Link Assy LH
Tie Rod End
Sub-assy LH
74 (755, 55)
19 (192, 14)
Speed Sensor Front LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Front Suspension Arm
Sub-assy Lower No.1 LH
294 (3,000, 217)
Front Axle Hub LH Nut
49 (500, 36)
Non-reusable parts
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified Torque
Cotter Pin
127 (1,300, 94)
F46819
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3019
30-6
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
LH:
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT / AXLE
Front Drive Shaft Dust Cover LH
Front Drive Inboard Joint Assy LH
Front Drive Inner Shaft Inner LH Shaft Snap Ring
Front Axle Inboard Joint Boot LH No.2 Clamp
Tripod Joint Assy
One Touch Type
Front Axle Inboard Joint Boot LH Clamp
3MZ-FE(FF)
Omega Type
Claw Engagement Type
Inboard Joint Boot
One Touch Type
Drive Shaft Damper
Front Axle Inboard Joint Boot LH Clamp
One Touch Type
3MZ-FE(FF)
Omega Type
Claw Engagement Type
3MZ-FE(FF)
Omega Type
Drive Shaft Damper Clamp
Front Axle Outboard Joint Boot LH Clamp
One Touch Type
Outboard Joint Boot
Front Axle Outboard Joint Boot LH No.2 Clamp
One Touch Type
Supply
parts:
Front Drive Outboard Joint Shaft Assy LH
Supply
parts:
3MZ-FE(FF)
Omega Type
Non-reusable parts
F46820
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3020
30-7
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT / AXLE
RH:
Front Axle Outboard Joint Boot RH No.2 Clamp
OmegType
One Touch Type
Supply
parts
3MZ-FE(FF):
Claw Engagement
Type
Outboard Joint Boot
Front Axle Outboard Joint Boot RH Clamp
Front Axle Inboard Joint
Boot RH No.2 Clamp
3MZ-FE(FF):
w/o: 3MZ-FE (4WD)
Drive Shaft Damper Clamp
3MZ-FE(FF):
Drive Shaft Damper
Front Axle Inboard
Joint Boot RH Clamp
Supply
parts
Inboard Joint Boot
3MZ-FE(FF):
Front Drive Outboard Joint Shaft Assy RH
3MZ-FE(FF):
Front Drive Inboard
Joint Assy RH
2MZ-FE(FF):
Front Drive Inboard Joint Assy RH
Front Axle Inboard Joint
Boot RH No.2 Clamp
Tripod Joint Assy
Front Drive Shaft Bearing
Case Snap Ring
Front Drive Inner Shaft
Inner RH Shaft Snap Ring
Front Drive Shaft Bearing
Straight Pin
Front Drive Shaft
Hole Snap Ring
(4WD):
Front Drive Inboard Joint Assy RH
Front Drive
Shaft Bearing
Front Drive Shaft Dust Cover RH
Front Drive Shaft Hole Snap Ring
Front Drive Shaft Dust Cover
Front Drive Shaft Bearing Case
Front Drive Shaft Dust Cover RH
Front Drive Shaft Dust Cover
Front Drive Shaft Dust Cover RH
Non-reusable parts
F46821
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3021
30-8
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT / AXLE
Front Shock Absorber LH
230 (2,345, 170)
19 (192, 14)
Speed Sensor
Front LH
Tie Rod End
Sub-assy LH
Front Drive
Shaft LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.·lbf)
Steering Knuckle with Axle Hub
Front Disc Brake
Caliper Assy LH
107 (1,090, 79)
Front Disc
Front Suspension Arm
Sub-assy Lower No.1 LH
Front Wheel Bearing
Dust Deflector No.1 LH
49 (500, 36)
Front Axle Hub Bolt
294 (3,000, 217)
127 (1,300, 94)
Front Axle Hub LH Hole Snap Ring
Cotter Pin
Front Axle Hub
LH Nut
Steering Knuckle LH
Front Axle Hub
LH Bearing
Disc Brake Dust Cover
Front LH
Cotter Pin
123 (1,250, 90)
8.3 (85, 74 in.·lbf)
Front Axle Hub
Sub-assy LH
Lower Ball Joint Assy
Front LH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
F45572
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3022
30-9
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT / AXLE
Rear Drive Shaft Inboard
Joint LH Shaft Snap Ring
Rear Drive Shaft Assy LH
Rear Axle Carrier Sub-assy LH
Rear Suspension Arm Assy No.2 LH
180 (1,840, 133)
112 (1,140, 83)
Rear Suspension
Arm Assy No.1 LH
112 (1,140, 83)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Speed Sensor Rear LH
294 (3,000, 217)
Rear Axle Shaft
LH Nut
80 (816, 59)
Strut Rod Assy Rear
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
G25993
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3023
30-10
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT / AXLE
FF:
Rear Axle Carrier Sub-assy LH
180 (1,840, 133)
Rear Suspension Arm Assy No.2 LH
112 (1,140, 83)
Skid Control Sensor
19 (192, 14)
78 (800, 58)
112 (1,140, 83)
78 (800, 58)
Rear Suspension Arm Assy No.1 LH
80 (816, 59)
Rear Disc Brake
Caliper Assy LH
75 (765, 55)
Strut Rod Assy Rear
Rear Axle
Hub & Bearing
Assy LH
Rear Disc
75 (765, 55)
Rear Axle LH Hub Bolt
Non-reusable part
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
G25994
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3024
30-1 1
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT / AXLE
4WD:
Rear Drive Shaft Assy LH
180 (1,840, 133)
Rear Axle Carrier Sub-assy LH
Rear Suspension Arm Assy No.2 LH
112 (1,140, 83)
Rear Suspension Arm
Assy No.1 LH
19 (192, 14)
78 (800, 58)
Speed Sensor Rear LH
112 (1,140, 83)
78 (800, 58)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Rear Disc Brake
Caliper Assy LH
80 (816, 59)
75 (765, 55)
Strut Rod Assy Rear
Rear Axle
Hub & Bearing
Assy LH
Rear Disc
75 (765, 55)
Rear Axle LH Hub Bolt
294 (3,000, 217)
Rear Axle Shaft
LH Nut
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified Torque
Non-reusable parts
F45252
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3025
30-53
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (FF)
REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (FF)
300OL-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: SEE PAGE 30-4
Replace the RH side by the same procedures with LH side.
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
(a)
SEPARATE RR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY RH
Remove the bolt and separate the flexible hose.
(b)
(c)
Remove the 2 bolts and brake caliper.
Support the brake caliper securely.
C83014
C83008
3.
4.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 32-29 )
SEPARATE SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
Disconnect the connector.
5.
(a)
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH
Remove the 4 bolts and axle hub.
G32184
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3067
30-54
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
6.
(a)
-
REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (FF)
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH
Install the axle hub with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
G32184
7.
(a)
INSTALL SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
Connect the connector.
8.
(a)
INSPECT BEARING BACKLASH
Set a dial indicator near the center of the axle hub and
check the backlash in the bearing shaft direction.
Maximum: 0 mm (0 in.)
If the backlash exceeds the maximum, replace the axle hub assembly.
C83015
9.
(a)
INSPECT AXLE HUB DEVIATION
Using a dial indicator, check the deviation at the surface
of the axle hub outside the hub bolt.
Maximum: 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If the backlash exceeds the maximum, replace the axle hub assembly.
C83016
10.
INSTALL REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 32-29 )
11.
(a)
INSTALL RR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY RH
Install the brake caliper with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 78 N⋅m (800 kgf⋅cm, 58 ft⋅lbf)
C83008
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3068
30-55
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
(b)
-
REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (FF)
Install the flexible hose with the bolt.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
C83014
12.
13.
14.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3069
30-56
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
-
REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (4WD)
REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (4WD)
300ON-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: SEE PAGE 30-4
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR REAR LH
3.
(a)
SST
C89299
F45516
REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT
Using SST and a hammer, unstake the staked part of the
axle hub LH nut.
SST 09930-00010
NOTICE:
Loosen the staked part of the nut completely, otherwise the
screw of the drive shaft may be damaged.
(b) While applying the brakes, remove the lock axle hub LH
nut.
4.
(a)
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Remove the bolt, and separate the flexible hose from the
shock absorber.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and separate rear disc brake caliper
assy.
NOTICE:
Use a string or other device to keep the brake caliper from
hanging down.
G24026
5.
REMOVE REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 32-29 )
6.
(a)
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH
Remove the 4 bolts and the rear axle hub & bearing assy
LH.
G32185
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3070
30-57
DRIVE SHAFT / PROPELLER SHAFT
7.
(a)
-
REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (4WD)
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH
Install the rear axle hub & bearing assy LH with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 75 N⋅m (765 kgf⋅cm, 55 ft⋅lbf)
G32185
8.
INSTALL REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 32-29 )
9.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Install the rear disc brake caliper assy LH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 78 N⋅m (800 kgf⋅cm, 58 ft⋅lbf)
Install the flexible hose with the bolt to the shock absorber.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (192 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
G24026
10.
(a)
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT
Install a new axle shaft LH nut.
Torque: 294 N⋅m, (3,000 kgf⋅cm, 217 ft⋅lbf)
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
REMOVE REAR DISC
INSPECT BEARING BACKLASH (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
INSPECT AXLE HUB DEVIATION (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
INSTALL REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 32-29 )
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
17.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT
Install a new axle shaft LH nut.
Torque: 294 N⋅m, (3,000 kgf⋅cm, 217 ft⋅lbf)
Using a chisel and a hammer, stake the axle shaft LH nut.
C89301
18.
19.
20.
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR LH
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3071
31-4
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER OIL (4WD)
TRANSFER OIL (4WD)
3100S-04
ADJUSTMENT
1.
2.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-2 )
0 to 5 mm
(0 to 0.1968 in.)
C70667
C83746
3.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT TRANSFER OIL
Remove the No.1 plug and gasket.
Check the oil level is within 0 to 5 mm (0 to 0.1968 in.)
down from the lowest end of the hole for No.1 plug.
NOTICE:
When changing oil, recheck the oil level after driving.
Excessively large or small quantity of oil may cause
some trouble.
(c) When the oil level is too low, check for oil leakage.
(d) Tighten the No.1 plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
4.
ADD TRANSFER OIL
(a) Remove the No.1 plug and gasket and supply oil.
NOTICE:
When supplying oil, pour it slowly.
Repeat supplying oil several times at several minutes interval.
HINT:
Within 0 to 5 mm (0 to 0.1968 in.) down from the lowest end of the hole for the No.1 plug.
(b) After leaving it alone for 5 min., check the oil level again.
(c) Tighten the No. 1 plug with a new gasket.
5.
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
6.
INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-2 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3082
31-1
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER SYSTEM (4WD)
TRANSFER SYSTEM (4WD)
3100Q-05
PRECAUTION
Before disassembly, clean the transfer assy and remove any deposited sand or mud to prevent
it from entering the inside of the transfer during disassembly and assembly.
When removing any light alloy part such as a transfer cover, do not pry it off with a tool like a
screwdriver but tap it out with a plastic hammer.
Always organize the removed parts properly and protect them away from dust.
After cleaning and drying completely before installation, apply hypoid gear oil to each part. Do
not use alkaline chemicals when cleansing aluminum or rubber parts and ring gear set bolts.
Also, do not use any cleansing oil (ex. white gasoline) to clean the rubber parts such as O rings
and oil seals.
Sufficiently apply hypoid gear oil to any sliding surface or rotating part.
Do not directly hold a part by vise. Make sure to put an aluminum sheet between them.
Replace any damaged or deformed snap ring with new one.
If mating surface of the case is scratched, it may cause oil leakage. Therefore, carefully avoid
such damage when handling.
Before applying a sealant, completely remove old sealant stuck on the sealed parts and clean
them with white gasoline.
Do not supply oil immediately after installing sealed parts. Allow 1 hour or more.
Scratches on a contact surface with an oil seal, O ring or gasket may result in oil leakage. Carefully avoid such damage when handling.
When press-fitting an oil seal, take care to prevent the oil seal lip and its periphery from being
damaged.
When replacing a bearing, replace both outer and inner races as one set.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3079
31-2
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER SYSTEM (4WD)
3100P-04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Noise
1. Oil (Level low)
2. Backlash adjustment
3. Preload adjustment
4. Tooth contact adjustment
5. Transfer driven pinion bearing (Worn)
6. Ring gear mounting case bearing (Worn)
31-4
31-9
31-9
31-9
31-9
31-9
Oil leakage
1. Oil (Level high)
2. Oil seal (Worn or damage)
3. Oil seal (Worn or damage)
4. Oil seal (Worn or damage)
5. Gasket (Damaged)
6. Seal (Damaged)
31-4
31-5
31-7
31-8
31-9
31-9
Right bearing retainer
Transfer case
Extension housing
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3080
31-5
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER OIL SEAL (4WD)
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER OIL SEAL (4WD)
3100T-07
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
(a)
(b)
4.
5.
(a)
6.
7.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-2 )
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
Remove the drain plug, gasket and drain ATF.
Install a new gasket and drain plug.
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE NO.1 PLUG
REMOVE TRANSFER DRAIN PLUG
Remove the transfer drain plug, drain gasket and bleed the drain transfer oil.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST 09520-01010, 09520-24010 (09520-32040)
8.
REMOVE TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the right bearing retainer oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
NOTICE:
Do not damage the oil-seal-fitted surface of the case.
SST
C68563
C83628
9.
C68564
0.7 - 1.3 mm
(0.0275 - 0.0511 in.)
INSTALL TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST, drive a new oil seal into the case to the position shown in the illustration.
SST 09223-4601 1
NOTICE:
Do not install the oil seal obliquely.
(b) Apply small amount of MP grease to the oil seal lip.
C83629
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
(a)
15.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (A/T TRANSAXLE)
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (A/T TRANSAXLE) (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
INSTALL TRANSFER DRAIN PLUG
Install the drain plug with a new gasket.
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE NO.1 PLUG
Supply oil up to the level 0 to 5 mm (0 to 0.1968 in.) down from the lowest end of the plug hole.
Oil quantity: 0.9 L (0.95 US qts, 0.71 lmp.qts)
NOTICE:
When supplying oil, be careful to do it slowly.
(b) Install the plug No. 1 with a new gasket.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
16. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
17. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY FRONT (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-2 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3083
31-6
TRANSFER
18.
19.
20.
-
TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER OIL SEAL (4WD)
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 26-7 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3084
31-7
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL (4WD)
TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL (4WD)
3100U-07
REPLACEMENT
1.
REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 14-149 )
REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 14-24 )
REMOVE TRANSVERSE ENGINE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 31-9 )
REMOVE TRANSFER STIFFENER PLATE RH (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION W/TRANSFER (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 40-20 )
REMOVE TRANSFER ASSY (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
REMOVE CTR DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SLEEVE (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
SST 09308-00010
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
Using SST, remove the oil seal from the case.
SST 09308-00010
NOTICE:
Do not damage the oil-seal-fitted surface of the case.
SST
C50328
C83630
9.
(a)
SST
C50353
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
8.7 to 9.3 mm
(0.3425 to 0.3661 in.)
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
Using SST, drive a new oil seal into the case to the position shown in the illustration.
SST 09387-00010, 09950-70010 (09951-07150)
NOTICE:
Do not install it obliquely.
(b) Apply small amount of MP grease to the oil seal lip.
C83631
INSTALL CTR DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SLEEVE (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00610), 09950-70010 (09951-07150)
INSTALL TRANSFER ASSY (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
INSTALL TRANSFER STIFFENER PLATE RH (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
INSTALL TRANSVERSE ENGINE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 31-9 )
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION W/TRANSFER (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 40-20 )
INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-24 )
Author:
Date:
3085
31-8
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T OIL
SEAL (4WD)
TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T OIL SEAL (4WD)
3100V-07
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-2 )
TRANSFER CASE NO.1 PLUG
TRANSFER DRAIN PLUG
PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (SEE PAGE 30-12 )
6.
REMOVE TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T
OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal from the extension housing.
SST 09308-00010
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil-seal-fitted surface and the
inside surface of the bush.
SST
C52790
C83632
7.
SST
1.1 to 1.9 mm
(0.0433 to 0.0748 in.)
C52791
C83633
INSTALL TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T
OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, drive a new oil seal into the extension housing
to the position shown in the illustration.
SST 09550- 60010 (09951- 00380, 09951- 00580,
09952-06010), 09950-70010 (09951-07150)
NOTICE:
Do not install the oil seal obliquely.
(b) Apply small amount of MP grease to the oil seal lip.
8.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY
(SEE PAGE 30-12 )
9.
FULLY TIGHTEN PROPELLER W/CENTER BEARING SHAFT ASSY (SEE PAGE 30-12 )
10. INSTALL TRANSFER DRAIN PLUG
(a) Install the drain plug with a new gasket.
11. INSTALL TRANSFER CASE NO.1 PLUG
(a) Supply oil up to the level 0 to 5 mm (0 to 0.1968 in.) down from the lowest end of the plug hole.
Oil quantity: 0.9 L (0.95 US qts, 0.71 lmp.qts)
NOTICE:
When supplying oil, be careful to do it slowly.
(b) Install the No. 1 plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
12. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-5 )
13. INSTALL EXHAUST PIPE ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 15-2 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3086
31-9
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
31050-02
OVERHAUL
HINT:
COMPONENT:
3MZ-FE ENGINE: See page 14-134
2AZ-FE ENGINE: See page 14-15
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (U151E/U151F): See page 40-18
TRANSFER: See page 31-3
1.
REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 14-149 )
2.
REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 14-24 )
3.
(a)
(b)
No.2 Plug
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE NO.1 PLUG
Remove the transfer case No.1 plug.
Remove the gasket No.1 from the transfer case No.1
plug.
No.1 Plug
Drain Plug
C82977
4.
(a)
(b)
5.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE NO.2 PLUG
Remove the transfer case No.2 plug.
Remove the gasket No.2 from the transfer case No.2 plug.
REMOVE TRANSFER DRAIN PLUG
Remove the transfer drain plug and bleed the transfer oil.
Remove the drain gasket from the transfer drain plug.
6.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER STIFFENER PLATE RH (2AZ-FE
ENGINE TYPE)
Remove the 5 bolts and the stiffener plate RH.
F45388
7.
(a)
8.
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RR (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
Remove the 3 bolts and the engine mounting bracket RR.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION W/TRANSFER (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 40-20 )
Author:
Date:
3087
31-10
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
9.
(a)
(b)
C82785
REMOVE TRANSFER ASSY
Remove the 2 bolts and 6 nuts.
Using a plastic hammer, remove the transfer assy from
the transaxle assy.
NOTICE:
Remove the transfer assy from the transaxle assy
without tilting it.
When removing the transfer assy, do not hold onto
the oil seal parts on both sides of the assy.
10.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER COVER GASKET
Remove the transfer cover gasket from the transfer assy.
C82798
11.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE BREATHER PLUG
Using a screwdriver and a hammer, remove the transfer
case breather plug from the transfer case cover No.1.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surface of the case
cover No.1.
C94714
12.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE COVER NO.1
Remove the 8 bolts.
C83507
(b)
Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the transfer
case cover No.1 from the transfer.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the case
and cover.
C50303
Author:
Date:
3088
31-1 1
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
13.
(a)
REMOVE BREATHER OIL DEFLECTOR
Remove the bolt and breather oil deflector from the transfer case cover No.1.
14.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER DYNAMIC DAMPER
Remove the 3 bolts and the transfer dynamic damper
from the transfer extension housing sub-assy.
C67665
C82802
15.
(a)
16.
(a)
17.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE STRAIGHT PIN
Remove the 4 transfer case straight pins from the transfer case.
REMOVE TRANSFER & TRANSAXLE SETTING STUD BOLT
Remove the 4 transfer & transaxle setting stud bolts.
FIX TRANSFER ASSY
Fix the transfer assy to the overhaul attachment.
18.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING DUST
DEFLECTOR
Using a plastic hammer, remove the transfer extension
housing dust deflector from the transfer extension housing sub-assy.
C82788
19.
REMOVE TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T
OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the transfer extension housing type
T oil seal from the transfer extension housing.
SST 09308-00010
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil-seal-fitted surface of the
housing and the inside surface of the bush.
SST
C82978
Author:
Date:
3089
31-12
TRANSFER
20.
(a)
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
REMOVE TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
SUB-ASSY
Remove the 4 bolts.
C82790
(b)
Using a plastic hammer, remove the transfer extension
housing sub-assy from the transfer case.
21.
(a)
INSPECT PRELOAD
Using SST and a torque wrench, check the initial torque
within the backlash range.
SST 09326-2001 1
Torque (preload): 0.9 to 1.4 N⋅m
(9 to 14 kgf⋅cm, 8.0 to 12.4 in.⋅lbf)
C82791
SST
HINT:
C82792
C83635
(b)
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 160 mm
(6.30 in.)
If the value is out of standard range, replace the driven
pinion bearing.
Using SST and a torque wrench, check the initial torque
while the driven pinion is in contact with the ring gear face.
SST 09326-2001 1
Torque: Preload + 0.15 to 0.30 N⋅m
(+1.6 to 3.1 kgf⋅cm, +1.3 to 2.7 in.⋅lbf)
HINT:
C50309
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 160 mm
(6.30 in.)
If the value is out of standard range, overhaul the transfer.
22. INSPECT BACKLASH
(a) Set the dial indicator perpendicular to the tooth face of the
ring gear, fix the driven pinion and inspect the backlash
while moving the gear.
Backlash: 0.10 to 0.15 mm (0.0039 to 0.0059 in.)
NOTICE:
Inspect it at 3 points or more on the gear’s periphery.
HINT:
Write down the result.
Author:
Date:
3090
31-13
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
23.
INSPECT TOOTH CONTACT BETWEEN RING GEAR
AND DRIVEN PINION
(a) Apply red lead primer thinly and uniformly to both faces
of the ring gear and rotate several times.
NOTICE:
Inspect the tooth contact on the ring gear at 4 places or
more.
(b) Proper washer location is shown in the illustration.
C50346
Heel Contact
Face Contact
Select an adjusting washer that will bring
the driven pinion closer to the ring gear.
Toe Contact
Flank Contact
Proper Contact
Select an adjusting washer that will shift
the drive pinion away from the ring gear.
C30886
K3673
C50310
C83636
24.
(a)
REMOVE CTR DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SLEEVE
Using snap ring pliers, remove the shaft snap ring.
(b)
Using SST, remove the CTR differential lock sleeve.
SST 09308-00010
C83637
SST
C51144
C83638
Author:
Date:
3091
31-14
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
25.
(a)
REMOVE O-RING
Using a screwdriver with the tip protected by vinyl tape,
remove the O-ring from the CTR differential lock sleeve.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the lock sleeve’s groove for the
O-ring.
C50311
26.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
Using SST, remove the transfer case oil seal from the
case.
SST 09308-00010
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil-seal-fitted surface of the
case.
C50328
SST
C83630
27.
REMOVE TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the transfer RH bearing retainer oil
seal from the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy.
SST 09308-00010
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil-seal-fitted surface of the
retainer.
SST
C82980
28.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
SUB-ASSY
Remove the 7 bolts from the transfer RH bearing retainer
sub-assy .
C83509
(b)
Using a screwdriver and a hammer, create a clearance
between the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy and
the transfer case.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the transfer RH bearing retainer
sub-assy and the transfer case.
C82797
Author:
Date:
3092
31-15
TRANSFER
(c)
SST
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
Using SST, remove the transfer RH bearing retainer subassy from the transfer case.
SST 09520-10021
C82981
29.
(a)
REMOVE O-RING
Using a screwdriver with the tip protected by vinyl tape,
remove the 2 O-rings from the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the retainer’s grooves for the Orings.
C50313
30.
SST
C50315
C83639
REMOVE CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Fix the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy in a vise.
(b) Using SST, remove the center differential case tapered
roller bearing RH outer race, transfer ring gear mounting
case washer No.2 and right bearing retainer oil seal No.2
from the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy.
SST 09308-00010
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil-seal-fitted surface of the
transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy.
31.
(a)
(b)
C50316
REMOVE SIDE GEAR SHAFT HOLDER BEARING
Using snap ring pliers, remove the side gear shaft holder
hole snap ring.
Remove the side gear shaft holder bearing from the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy.
C83640
Author:
Date:
3093
31-16
TRANSFER
32.
(a)
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
REMOVE TRANSFER RING GEAR MOUNTING CASE
Remove the transfer ring gear mounting case from the
transfer case.
C67673
33.
SST
C67674
C83641
SST
C67685
C83642
SST
C68270
C83643
REMOVE CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) LH side:
Using SST, remove the inner race of the center differential
case tapered roller bearing from the transfer ring gear
mounting case.
SST 09950- 40011 (09951- 04010, 09952- 04010,
09953- 04020, 09954- 04010, 09955- 04061,
09957- 04010, 09958- 04011), 09950- 60010
(09951-00420)
NOTICE:
Apply grease to the screw thread and tip of the SST before
use.
HINT:
When the roller comes off due to deformation of the gauge,
completely remove the roller and remaining inner races of the
center differential case tapered roller bearing from the transfer
ring gear mounting case.
SST 09950- 00020, 09950- 00030, 09950- 60010
(09951-00430)
NOTICE:
Apply grease to the screw thread and tip of the SST before
use.
(b) RH side:
Using SST, remove the inner race of the center differential
case tapered roller bearing from the transfer ring gear
mounting case.
SST 09950- 40011 (09951- 04010, 09952- 04010,
09953- 04020, 09954- 04010, 09955- 04061,
09957- 04010, 09958- 04011), 09950- 60010
(09951-00360)
NOTICE:
Apply grease to the screw thread and tip of the SST before
use.
Author:
Date:
3094
31-17
TRANSFER
SST
C50320
C83644
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
HINT:
When the roller comes off due to deformation of the gauge,
completely remove the roller and remaining inner races of the
center differential case tapered roller bearing from the transfer
ring gear mounting case.
SST 09950- 00020, 09950- 00030, 09950- 60010
(09951-00360)
NOTICE:
Apply grease to the screw thread and tip of the SST before
use.
34. REMOVE RING GEAR
(a) Put matchmarks on the transfer ring gear mounting case
and the ring gear.
(b) Remove the 12 bolts.
Matchmarks
C67676
C83645
(c)
Using a plastic hammer, remove the ring gear by tapping
around its periphery.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the teeth of the ring gear.
HINT:
If the runout is too large, replace the transfer ring rear mounting
case.
C67677
35.
(a)
INSPECT RUNOUT OF TRANSFER RING GEAR
MOUNTING CASE
Using a dial indicator, check the transfer ring gear mounting case runout.
Maximum runout: 0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
HINT:
If the runout is too large, replace the center differential control
coupling assy or transfer ring gear mounting case.
C99000
36.
(a)
SST
REMOVE DRIVEN PINION
Using SST and a hammer, unstake the transfer gear nut.
SST 09930-00010
C82795
Author:
Date:
3095
31-18
TRANSFER
(b)
SST
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
Using SST, remove the transfer gear nut.
SST 09326-2001 1, 09556-16030
SST
C82984
(c)
Using a press, remove the driven pinion, transfer driven
pinion rear bearing inner race and transfer pinion bearing
spacer.
NOTICE:
Put a shop rag around to help prevent the driven pinion from being dropped.
Place something like wooden blocks under the case
to keep it level.
C82796
37.
SST
C50327
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER DRIVEN PINION FRONT
BEARING
Using SST and a press, remove the transfer driven pinion
front bearing inner race from the driven pinion.
SST 09950-00020
C83646
38.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER DRIVEN PINION FRONT
BEARING
Using a brass bar and a hammer, lightly strike the center
differential case tapered roller bearing LH outer race at 2
points to remove it from the transfer case.
C50329
39.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER OUTPUT WASHER
Remove the ring gear mounting case plate washer from the transfer case.
Author:
Date:
3096
31-19
TRANSFER
40.
(a)
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
REMOVE CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Using a brass bar and a hammer, lightly strike the transfer
driven pinion front bearing outer race at 2 points to remove it from the transfer case.
C82781
41.
(a)
REMOVE RING GEAR MOUNTING CASE PLATE WASHER
Remove the transfer output washer from the transfer case.
42.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSFER DRIVEN PINION REAR
BEARING
Using a brass bar and a hammer, lightly strike the transfer
driven pinion rear bearing outer race at 2 points to remove
it from the transfer case.
C50331
43.
SST
C82982
INSTALL TRANSFER DRIVEN PINION REAR
BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, install the transfer driven pinion
rear bearing outer race to the transfer case.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00620), 09950- 70010
(09951-07150)
NOTICE:
Place something like wooden blocks under the case to
keep its level.
44. INSTALL TRANSFER OUTPUT WASHER
(a) Install the transfer output washer to the transfer case.
HINT:
Reuse the washer.
45.
SST
(a)
C50335
INSTALL TRANSFER DRIVEN PINION FRONT
BEARING
Install the transfer driven pinion front bearing outer race
to the transfer case with SST, bolt and nut.
SST 09950- 60020 (09951- 00750, 09951- 00770,
09951-00810), 09316-60011 (09316-00061)
C83647
Author:
Date:
3097
31-20
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
46. INSTALL RING GEAR MOUNTING CASE PLATE WASHER
(a) Install the ring gear mounting case plate washer to the transfer case.
HINT:
Reuse the washer.
47.
(a)
SST
C50336
C83648
48.
SST
C50337
INSTALL CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Using SST and a press, install the center differential case
tapered roller bearing LH outer race to the transfer case.
SST 09950- 70010 (09951- 07200), 09316- 60011
(09316-00021)
(a)
INSTALL TRANSFER DRIVEN PINION FRONT
BEARING
Using SST and a press, install the transfer driven pinion
front bearing inner race to the driven pinion.
SST 09316-6001 1 (09316-00041)
49.
(a)
INSTALL DRIVEN PINION
Install the driven pinion to the transfer case.
(b)
Install a new transfer pinion bearing spacer and a new
transfer driven pinion rear bearing inner race to the driven
pinion.
C83649
C50338
C50339
Author:
Date:
3098
31-21
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
(c)
SST
C82983
Using SST, tighten a new transfer gear nut (at a standard
torque.)
SST 09326-2001 1, 09556-16030
Torque:
277 to 378 N⋅m (2,820 to 3,855 kgf⋅cm, 204 to 279 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not stake the transfer gear nut.
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 750 mm (29.53 in.)
50.
(a)
SST
C82792
C83635
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 160 mm (6.30 in.)
NOTICE:
Measure preload after rotating the bearing both clockwise
and counterclockwise to make it fit.
(b) If the preload is too large, replace the transfer pinion
bearing spacer with a new one.
(c) If the preload is too small, repeatedly adjust the preload
by tightening the transfer gear nut 5 to 10 degrees at a
time until the standard value is obtained.
(d) If the preload is insufficient, even though the tightening
torque of the transfer gear nut exceeds the maximum of
the standard value, loosen the transfer gear nut and apply
gear oil SAE 90 (GL-5) to the transfer gear nut and the
screw thread and the base of the driven pinion. And then
repeat the preceding operation. If the tightening torque is
smaller than the standard, replace the transfer pinion
bearing spacer with a new one and adjust it.
SST 09326-2001 1, 09556-16030
Torque: 378 N⋅m (3,855 kgf⋅cm, 279 ft⋅lbf)
51.
(a)
Boiling Water
INSPECT AND ADJUST DRIVEN PINION PRELOAD
Using SST and a torque wrench, measure the initial
torque of the driven pinion.
Preload (at starting):
New bearing:
1.1 to 1.6 N⋅m (11 to 16 kgf⋅cm, 9.7 to 14.2 in.⋅lbf)
Used bearing:
0.9 to 1.4 N⋅m (9 to 14 kgf⋅cm, 8.0 to 12.4 in.⋅lbf)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL RING GEAR
Completely remove grease and moisture on the contact
surfaces of the ring gear and the transfer ring gear mounting case.
Heat the ring gear in boiling water from 90 to 100C (194
to 212F).
Carefully take the ring gear out of the boiling water.
SA1143
Author:
Date:
3099
31-22
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
(d)
Matchmarks
C50361
C83652
Align the matchmarks on the ring gear and transfer ring
gear mounting case and quickly assemble them.
(e) Tighten the12 bolts.
Torque: 78 N⋅m (790 kgf⋅cm, 57 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten the bolts in diagonal order in splitting several
times.
After the ring gear has well cooled down, fully tighten
the bolts.
Make the bolt heads in order to check if they are retightened or not.
52.
SST
C50342
C83653
SST
INSTALL CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) RH side:
Using SST and a press, install the inner race of the center
differential case tapered roller bearing to the transfer ring
gear mounting case.
SST 09506-35010, 09950-60010 (09951-00430)
NOTICE:
When replacing the inner race, replace it together with the
outer race.
(b) LH side:
Using SST and a press, install the inner race of the center
differential case tapered roller bearing to the transfer ring
gear mounting case.
SST 09223-00010
NOTICE:
When replacing the inner race, replace it together with the
outer race.
C67688
53.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSFER RING GEAR MOUNTING CASE
Install the transfer ring gear mounting case to the transfer
case.
NOTICE:
Damage to the spline, the bearing’s rotating surface and
gear face may cause a decrease in their strength. Care
should be taken when installing them.
C67673
54. INSTALL TRANSFER RING GEAR MOUNTING CASE WASHER NO.2
(a) Install the transfer ring gear mounting case washer No.2 to the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy.
HINT:
Reuse the washer.
Author:
Date:
3100
31-23
TRANSFER
55.
SST
(a)
C50344
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
INSTALL CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Using SST and a press, install the center differential case
tapered roller bearing RH outer race to the transfer RH
bearing retainer sub-assy.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00620), 09950- 70010
(09951-07150)
C83654
56.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
SUB-ASSY
Place the transfer with the face where the transfer RH
bearing retainer sub-assy is to be installed facing up.
Center-align the transfer ring gear mounting case and
the transfer case.
C57486
(c)
Insert the SST into the transfer RH bearing retainer subassy.
SST 09387-00090
NOTICE:
Insert SST straight in order not to damage the oil seal lip.
SST
C57487
(d)
Insert the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy together
with the SST into the transfer case.
NOTICE:
Interference between the case and retainer, and between
the transfer ring gear mounting case and SST should be
carefully avoided.
HINT:
If the retainer cannot be inserted, tap it in with a plastic hammer.
C57488
(e)
After inserting the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy
into the transfer case, remove the SST.
C57489
Author:
Date:
3101
31-24
TRANSFER
(f)
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
Tighten the 7 bolts.
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
C83509
57.
(a)
C50309
Mark
Washer Thickness
AA
2.07 (0.0814)
mm (in.)
INSPECT BACKLASH
Set the dial indicator perpendicular to the ring gear face,
fix the driven pinion, and check backlash by moving the
ring gear.
Backlash: 0.10 to 0.15 mm (0.0039 to 0.0059 in.)
NOTICE:
Measure it at 3 points or more on the ring gear periphery.
(b) If the measured value is out of standard, select a proper
washer for the center differential case tapered roller bearing on the LH side from the table below and install it to obtain the standard value.
Mark
Washer Thickness
mm (in.)
AB
2.10 (0.0826)
Mark
Washer Thickness
AC
2.13 (0.0838)
BA
2.16 (0.0850)
BB
2.19 (0.0862)
BC
2.22 (0.0874)
CA
2.25 (0.0885)
CB
2.28 (0.0897)
CC
2.31 (0.0909)
DA
2.34 (0.0921)
DB
2.37 (0.0933)
DC
2.40 (0.0944)
EA
2.43 (0.0956)
EB
2.46 (0.0968)
EC
2.49 (0.0980)
FA
2.52 (0.0992)
FB
2.55 (0.1003)
FC
2.58 (0.1015)
GA
2.61 (0.1027)
GB
2.64 (0.1039)
GC
2.67 (0.1051)
HA
2.70 (0.1062)
HB
2.73 (0.1074)
HC
2.76 (0.1086)
JA
2.79 (0.1098)
JB
2.82 (0.1110)
JC
2.85 (0.1122)
KA
2.88 (0.1133)
KB
2.91 (0.1145)
KC
2.94 (0.1157)
LA
2.97 (0.1169)
LB
3.00 (0.1181)
mm (in.)
HINT:
When the backlash is larger or smaller than the standard, select
a thinner or thicker washer respectively.
(c)
Ring Gear Mounting
Case Plate Washer
C50345
Ring gear mounting case plate washer location is shown
in the illustration.
C83655
Author:
Date:
3102
31-25
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
58.
INSPECT TOOTH CONTACT BETWEEN RING GEAR
AND DRIVEN PINION
(a) Apply red lead primer thinly and uniformly to both faces
of the ring gear and rotate it several times.
NOTICE:
Check the tooth contact on the ring gear at 4 places or
more.
(b) Observe the pattern shown by red lead primer.
C50346
Face Contact
Heel Contact
Select an adjusting washer that will bring
the driven pinion closer to the ring gear.
Flank Contact
Toe Contact
Proper Contact
Select an adjusting washer that will shift
the drive pinion away from the ring gear.
C30886
K3673
C83636
(c)
In case of poor tooth contact, select a washer for the driven pinion bearing front side from the following table and
replace it.
NOTICE:
If the washer thickness is changed, the backlash will be
also changed.
Mark
Washer Thickness
mm (in.)
Mark
Washer Thickness
mm (in.)
Mark
Washer Thickness
AA
1.20 (0.0472)
AC
1.22 (0.0480)
BB
1.24 (0.0488)
CA
1.26 (0.0496)
CC
1.28 (0.0503)
DB
1.30 (0.0511)
EA
1.32 (0.0519)
EC
1.34 (0.0527)
FB
1.36 (0.0535)
GA
1.38 (0.0543)
GC
1.40 (0.0551)
HB
1.42 (0.0559)
JA
1.44 (0.0566)
JC
1.46 (0.0574)
KB
1.48 (0.0582)
LA
1.50 (0.0590)
LC
1.52 (0.0598)
MB
1.54 (0.0606)
NA
1.56 (0.0614)
NC
1.58 (0.0622)
PB
1.60 (0.0629)
QA
1.62 (0.0637)
QC
1.64 (0.0645)
Author:
Date:
mm (in.)
3103
31-26
TRANSFER
(d)
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
The location of the transfer output washer for tooth contact adjustment is shown in the illustration.
Transfer Output Washer
C50363
C83656
59.
(a)
SST
C82792
Mark
C83635
Washer Thickness
AA
1.47 (0.0578)
mm (in.)
Mark
ADJUST TOTAL PRELOAD
Using SST and a torque wrench, measure the initial
torque with the driven pinion being contact with the ring
gear face.
SST 09326-2001 1
Torque:
New bearing:
Driven pinion preload +0.2 to 0.4 N⋅m
(+2.3 to 3.9 kgf⋅cm, 1.8 to 3.5 in.⋅lbf)
Used bearing:
Driven pinion preload +0.15 to 0.30 N⋅m
(+1.6 to 3.1 kgf⋅cm, 1.3 to 2.7 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Before measurement, rotate the bearing in both directions
several times to make it fit.
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 160 mm (6.30 in.).
(b) If the value is out of standard range, select the washer for
the center differential case tapered roller bearing RH side
from the following table and replace it.
Washer Thickness
mm (in.)
AB
1.50 (0.0590)
Mark
Washer Thickness
AC
1.53 (0.0602)
BA
1.56 (0.0614)
BB
1.59 (0.0625)
BC
1.62 (0.0637)
CA
1.65 (0.0649)
CB
1.68 (0.0661)
CC
1.71 (0.0673)
DA
1.74 (0.0685)
DB
1.77 (0.0696)
DC
1.80 (0.0708)
EA
1.83 (0.0720)
EB
1.86 (0.0732)
EC
1.89 (0.0744)
FA
1.92 (0.0755)
FB
1.95 (0.0767)
FC
1.98 (0.0779)
GA
2.01 (0.0790)
GB
2.04 (0.0803)
GC
2.07 (0.0814)
HA
2.10 (0.0826)
HB
2.13 (0.0838)
HC
2.16 (0.0850)
JA
2.19 (0.0862)
JB
2.22 (0.0874)
JC
2.25 (0.0885)
KA
2.28 (0.0897)
KB
2.31 (0.0909)
KC
2.34 (0.0921)
LA
2.37 (0.0933)
LB
2.40 (0.0944)
LC
2.43 (0.0956)
MA
2.46 (0.0968)
MB
2.49 (0.0980)
MC
2.52 (0.0992)
NA
2.55 (0.1003)
NB
2.58 (0.1015)
Author:
Date:
mm (in.)
3104
31-27
TRANSFER
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
(c)
The location of the transfer ring gear mounting case
washer No.2 for preload adjustment is shown in the illustration.
(d)
Using a chisel, stake the transfer gear nut.
60.
REMOVE TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
SUB-ASSY
Remove the 7 bolts from the transfer RH bearing retainer
sub-assy .
Transfer Ring
Gear Mounting
Case Washer
No.2
C50349
-
C83657
C70532
(a)
C83509
(b)
Using a screwdriver and a hammer, make a opening between the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy and the
transfer case.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the transfer RH bearing retainer
sub-assy and the transfer case.
C82797
(c)
SST
Using SST, remove the transfer RH bearing retainer subassy from the transfer case.
SST 09520-10021
C82981
Author:
Date:
3105
31-28
TRANSFER
61.
SST
C50341
(a)
(b)
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
REMOVE CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Fix the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy in a vise.
Using SST, remove the center differential case tapered
roller bearing RH outer race and transfer ring gear mounting case washer No.2 from the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy.
SST 09308-00010
C83688
62.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SIDE GEAR SHAFT HOLDER BEARING
Install the side gear shaft holder bearing to the transfer
RH bearing retainer sub-assy.
Using snap ring pliers, install the side gear shaft holder
hole snap ring.
HINT:
Check that the side gear shaft holder hole snap ring fits in the
groove of the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy.
C50364
C83699
63.
INSTALL TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER OIL
SEAL
SST
1.5 to 2.5 mm
(a) Using SST and a press, install the transfer RH bearing re(0.059 to 0.098 in.)
tainer oil seal No.2 to the transfer RH bearing retainer
sub-assy .
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00350, 09951- 00560,
09952-06010), 09950-70010 (09951-07150)
NOTICE:
Carefully press-fit so that the oil seal will not be tilted.
C83689
C50350
(b) Apply small amount of MP grease No.2 to the oil seal lip.
64. INSTALL TRANSFER RING GEAR MOUNTING CASE WASHER NO.2
(a) Install the selected transfer ring gear mounting washer No.2 to the transfer RH bearing retainer subassy.
65.
SST
(a)
C51147
INSTALL CENTER DIFFERENTIAL CASE TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
Using SST and a press, install the center differential case
tapered roller bearing RH outer race to the transfer RH
bearing retainer sub-assy.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00620), 09950- 70010
(09951-07150)
C83690
Author:
Date:
3106
31-29
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
66.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL O-RING
Coat 2 new O-rings with hypoid gear oil.
Install the 2 O-rings to the transfer RH bearing retainer
sub-assy .
NOTICE:
Be careful not to twist the O-ring but to fit it properly in the
retainer’s groove.
C50352
67.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER
SUB-ASSY
Place the transfer with the surface where the transfer RH
bearing retainer sub-assy is facing up.
Align the centers of the transfer ring gear mounting case
and the transfer case.
C57486
(c)
Insert SST into the transfer RH bearing retainer subassy.
SST 09387-00090
NOTICE:
Insert SST straight in order not to damage the oil seal.
SST
C57487
(d)
C57488
Insert the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy together
with SST into the transfer case.
NOTICE:
Avoid interference between the case and the retainer,
and between the SST and the transfer ring gear
mounting case.
Carefully check the retainer’s O-ring for damage and
incorrect fitting.
HINT:
If the retainer cannot be inserted into the case, tap it in with a
plastic hammer.
Author:
Date:
3107
31-30
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
(e)
After inserting the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy
into the transfer case, remove the SST.
(f)
Tighten the 7 bolts.
Torque: 28 N⋅m (286 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
68.
(a)
INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
Using SST and a torque wrench, measure the initial
torque with the driven pinion being in contact with the ring
gear face.
SST 09326-2001 1
Torque:
New bearing:
Driven pinion preload +0.2 to 0.4 N⋅m
(+2.3 to 3.9 kgf⋅cm, 1.8 to 3.5 in.⋅lbf)
Used bearing:
Driven pinion preload +0.15 to 0.30 N⋅m
(+1.6 to 3.1 kgf⋅cm, +1.3 to 2.7 in.⋅lbf)
C57489
C83509
SST
C82792
C83650
HINT:
69.
0.7 to 1.3 mm
(0.028 to 0.051 in.)
C50351
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 160 mm
(6.30 in.).
If the preload is too large, inspect the transfer RH bearing
retainer sub-assy.
SST
C83691
INSTALL TRANSFER RH BEARING RETAINER OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST, install the transfer RH bearing retainer oil seal
to the transfer RH bearing retainer sub-assy to the position as shown in the illustration.
SST 09223-4601 1
NOTICE:
Install the oil seal carefully so that it will not be tilted.
(b) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
Author:
Date:
3108
31-31
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
70.
(a)
SST
8.7 to 9.3 mm
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE OIL SEAL
Using SST, install the transfer case oil seal to the transfer
case at the position as shown as in the illustration.
SST 09387-00010, 09950-70010 (09951-07150)
NOTICE:
Install the oil seal carefully so that it will not be tilted.
(b) Apply small amount of MP grease to the oil seal lip.
(0.343 to 0.366 in.)
C50353
C83631
71. INSTALL CTR DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SLEEVE
(a) Coat a new O-ring with hypoid gear oil.
(b) Install the O-ring to the CTR differential lock sleeve.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to twist the O-ring but to fit it properly in the
retainer’s groove.
C50354
(c)
Using SST, install the CTR differential lock sleeve to the
transfer case.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00610), 09950- 70010
(09951-07150)
SST
C51160
C83692
(d) Using snap ring pliers, install the shaft snap ring.
NOTICE:
Check that the snap ring is fitted in the groove of the ring
gear mounting case.
C50365
C83693
72.
1.1 to 1.9 mm
(0.043 to 0.075 in.)
SST
C50355
C83694
INSTALL TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING TYPE T
OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, install the transfer extension housing type T
oil seal to the transfer extension housing at the position
as shown in the illustration.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00380, 09951- 00580,
09952-06010), 09950-70010 (09951-07150)
NOTICE:
Install the oil seal carefully so that it will not be tilted.
(b) Apply small amount of MP grease No.2 to the oil seal lip.
Author:
Date:
3109
31-32
TRANSFER
73.
SST
(a)
C50356
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
INSTALL TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING DUST
DEFLECTOR
Using SST and a press, install a new transfer extension
housing dust deflector to the transfer extension housing
sub-assy .
SST 09950- 60020 (09951- 00710), 09950- 70010
(09951-07150)
C83695
74.
Sealant
C83047
C83696
INSTALL TRANSFER EXTENSION HOUSING
SUB-ASSY
(a) Apply sealant 1281 to the transfer extension housing
sub-assy in continuous beaded form of 1.2 mm diameter
as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Wipe any grease off from the attaching surfaces.
Install the transfer extension housing sub-assy within 10 minutes after applying the sealant.
(b)
(c)
Install the transfer extension housing sub-assy to the
transfer case with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 26 N⋅m (260 kgf⋅cm, 19 ft⋅lbf)
Remove the transfer assy from the overhaul attachment.
C82800
75.
Sealantcoated
part
C50332
INSTALL TRANSFER & TRANSAXLE SETTING STUD
BOLT
(a) Install the 4 transfer & transaxle setting stud bolts to the
parts of the transfer case as shown in the illustration.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 30 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Install the sealant-coated side of the transfer & transaxle
stud bolt to the transfer case.
D31105
Author:
Date:
3110
31-33
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
76.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE STRAIGHT PIN
Using a plastic hammer, install the 4 transfer case straight
pins to the transfer case as shown in the illustration.
77.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSFER DYNAMIC DAMPER
Install the transfer dynamic damper to the transfer extension housing sub-assy with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 26 N⋅m (260 kgf⋅cm, 19 ft⋅lbf)
6.5 to 7.5 mm
(0.256 to 0.295 in.)
10.8 to 11.8 mm
(0.425 to 0.465 in.)
C83712
C69282
C51143
78.
(a)
INSTALL BREATHER OIL DEFLECTOR
Install the breather oil deflector to the transfer case cover
No.1 with the bolt.
Torque: 6.5 N⋅m (66 kgf⋅cm, 57 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful of the direction of the deflector’s fold.
C67686
79.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE COVER NO.1
Apply sealant 1281 to the transfer case cover No.1 in a
continuous bead of 1.2 mm diameter as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Wipe any grease off from the attaching surfaces.
Install the transfer case cover No.1 within 10 minutes
after application of the sealant.
Sealant
C67689
C83713
Author:
Date:
3111
31-34
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
(b)
Install the transfer case cover No.1 to the transfer case
with the 8 bolts.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (200 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
80.
(a)
TRANSFER CASE BREATHER PLUG
Using SST and a hammer, install the transfer case breather plug to the transfer case cover No.1.
SST 09612-10061)
81.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSFER COVER GASKET
Install a new transfer cover gasket to the transfer case.
C83507
SST
D30774
C82798
82.
(a)
Driving Plug
INSTALL TRANSFER ASSY
Apply sealant 1281 to the transaxle assy and the transfer
assy in continuous beaded form of 1.2 mm diameter as
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Wipe any grease off from the attaching surfaces.
Install it within 10 minutes after applying the sealant.
Sealant stuck on the gasket, case oil seal and driving
plug may cause oil leakage and seizure due to oil
shortage. Care must be taken.
Sealant
Gasket
C51159
C83714
Author:
Date:
3112
31-35
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER ASSY (4WD)
(b)
83.
(a)
Install the transfer assy to the transaxle assy with the 2
bolts and 6 nuts.
Torque: 69 N⋅m (700 kgf⋅cm, 51 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Check that the gasket is installed to the transfer assy
before instaling them to the transaxle assy.
Install the transfer assy to the transaxle assy without
tilting.
When moving the transfer assy, do not hold the oil
C82785
seal on the both sides.
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RR (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
Install the engine mounting bracket RR with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 64 N⋅m (652 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
84.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSFER STIFFENER PLATE RH (2AZ-FE
ENGINE TYPE)
Install the stiffener plate RH with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 34 N⋅m (350 kgf⋅cm, 25 ft⋅lbf)
F45388
85.
86.
87.
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION W/TRANSFER (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 40-20 )
INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-24 )
No.2 Plug
No.1 Plug
88.
(a)
89.
(a)
Drain Plug
C82977
90.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSFER DRAIN PLUG
Install the transfer drain plug with a new drain gasket.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE NO.2 PLUG
Install the transfer case No.2 plug with a new gasket No.2.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL TRANSFER CASE NO.1 PLUG
Add oil up to 0 to 5 mm below the lower side of the plug
hole.
Oil quantity: 0.9 L (0.95 US qts, 0.79 lmp. qts)
HINT:
When adding oil, pour it slowly.
(b) Install the transfer case No.1 plug with a new gasket No.1.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
Author:
Date:
3113
31-3
TRANSFER
-
TRANSFER (4WD)
TRANSFER (4WD)
3100R-05
COMPONENTS
Transfer Case Breather Plug
Transfer Case Cover No. 1
Center Differential Case Tapered
Roller Bearing RH Inner Race
Breather Oil Deflector
x8
20 (200, 14)
6.5 (66, 57 in.⋅lbf)
Right Bearing
Retainer O-ring
Transfer RH Bearing
Retainer Oil Seal
78 (790, 57)
Center Differential Case
Tapered Roller Bearing
LH Inner Race
x12
Ring Gear
Center Differential Case Tapered
Roller Bearing LH Outer Race
O-ring
Transfer Ring Gear
Mounting Case
Ring Gear Mounting
Case Plate Washer
x7
Transfer Ring Gear Mounting
Case Washer No. 2
28 (286, 21)
Transfer RH Bearing
Center Differential Case Tapered
Roller Bearing RH Outer Race
Transfer Cover
Gasket
Transfer Case Straight Pin
Transfer
Transfer Case
CTR Differential
Lock Sleeve
Retainer Sub-assy
Case
No.2 Plug
49 (500, 36)
Transfer Case
Oil Seal
Side Gear Shaft
Gasket
No. 1
Gasket
No. 2
O-ring
Holder Bearing
Side Gear Shaft Holder
Hole Snap Ring
Transfer
RH Bearing
Retainer Oil Seal No. 2
Transfer Case
Shaft Snap Ring
Drain
Gasket
x4
Transfer Case
Straight Pin
No.1 Plug
49 (500, 36)
Transfer Drain Plug
49 (500, 36)
Transfer Driven Pinion
Rear Bearing Outer Race
Transfer Driven Pinion Rear
26 (260, 19)
Bearing Inner Race
Transfer & Transaxle
Setting Stud Bolt
39 (400, 29)
Transfer Gear Nut
295 to 403 (3,008 to 4,109, 218 to 297 )
*277 to 378 (2,820 to 3,855, 204 to 279)
Transfer Extension Housing Sub-assy
Transfer Extension
Transfer Extension
Housing Type T Oil
Seal
Driven Pinion
Transfer Driven Pinion
Front Bearing Inner Race
Housing
Dust Deflector
26 (260, 19)
Transfer Driven Pinion
Front Bearing Outer Race
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
*For use with SST
26 (260, 19)
Transfer Output Washer
Transfer Dynamic Damper
Transfer Pinion Bearing Spacer
D30404
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3081
32-1
BRAKE
-
BRAKE SYSTEM
BRAKE SYSTEM
320WA-03
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
Care must be taken to replace each part properly as it could affect the performance of the brake
system and result in a driving hazard. Replace the parts with parts having the same part number
or equivalent.
It is very important to keep parts and the area clean when repairing the brake system.
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to the precaution in the
INTRODUCTION section.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3114
32-2
BRAKE
-
BRAKE SYSTEM
320WB-07
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Refer to the table below to help find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the possible cause of problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
Symptom
Low pedal or spongy pedal
Suspected Area
See page
7. Fluid leaks in brake system
8. Air in brake system
9. Piston seals (Worn or damaged)
32-4
32-23
32-29
32-14
32-14
10.Master cylinder (Faulty)
11.Booster push rod (Out of adjustment)
1. Brake pedal free play (Minimal)
2. Parking brake pedal travel (Out of adjustment)
3. Parking brake wire (Sticking)
4. Parking brake shoe clearance (Out of adjustment)
5. Pad (Cracked or distorted)
Brake drag
6. Piston (Stuck)
7. Piston (Frozen)
8. Booster push rod (Out of adjustment)
9. Vacuum leaks in booster system
10. Master cylinder (Faulty)
1. Piston (Stuck)
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
2. Pad (Oily)
Brake pull
3. Piston (Frozen)
4. Disc (Scored)
5. Pad (Cracked or distorted)
1. Fluid leaks in brake system
2. Air in brake system
3. Pad (Worn)
32-4
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-14
32-17
4. Pad (Cracked or distorted)
Hard pedal but brake inefficient
32-8
33-2
33-10
33-14
33-19
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-14
32-17
32-14
5. Pad (Oily)
6. Pad (Glanzed)
7. Disc (Scored)
8. Booster push rod (Out of adjustment)
9. Vacuum leaks in booster system
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3115
32-3
BRAKE
-
BRAKE SYSTEM
1. Pad (Cracked or distorted)
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
32-23
32-29
2. Installation bolt (Loose)
3. Disc (Scored)
4. Pad support plate (Loose)
Brake noise
5. Sliding pin (Worn)
6. Pad (Dirty)
7. Pad (Glanzed)
8. Anti-squeal shim (Damaged)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3116
32-40
BRAKE
-
SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
3215T-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD SUB-ASSY LH
3.
(a)
REMOVE SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
(b)
Remove the 2 bolts and the clamp from the body and the
shock absorber assy.
F40298
F40299
(c) Remove the bolt and the speed sensor front.
NOTICE:
Prevent foreign matter from attaching to the sensor tip.
F40300
4.
(a)
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
Install the speed sensor front with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Prevent foreign matter from attaching to the sensor tip.
F40300
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3153
32-41
BRAKE
-
SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH
(b)
Install the speed sensor front with the 2 bolts and the
clamp.
Torque:
Bolt A: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
Bolt B: 19 N⋅m (192 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not twist the sensor wire when installing the sensor.
Bolt A
Bolt B
Clamp
F40299
(c)
Connect the speed sensor connector.
F40298
5.
6.
7.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD SUB-ASSY LH
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3154
32-42
BRAKE
-
SKID CONTROL SENSOR (FF)
SKID CONTROL SENSOR (FF)
320WO-03
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
(a)
3.
4.
5.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
DISCONNECT SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
Disconnect the connector from the skid control sensor.
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-53 )
REMOVE REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 30-53 )
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-53 )
6.
REMOVE SKID CONTROL SENSOR
(a) Mount the hub & bearing assy on a soft jaw vise.
NOTICE:
Replace the hub & bearing assy if it is dropped or receives
a strong shock.
(b) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the 2 pins and
remove the 2 attachments from SST.
(c)
Using SST and 2 bolts (Diameter: 12 mm, pitch: 1.5 mm),
remove the skid control sensor from the hub & bearing
assy.
SST 09520- 00031 (09520- 00040), 09521- 00020,
09950-00020
NOTICE:
If damage is inflicted to the sensor rotor, replace the
hub & bearing assy.
Do not scratch the contacting surface of the hub &
bearing assy and the skid control sensor.
SST
Bolt
SST
SST
F40303
LH:
7.
(a)
INSTALL SKID CONTROL SENSOR
Clean the contacting surface of the rear axle hub and a
assy and a new skid control sensor.
NOTICE:
Prevent foreign matter from attaching to the sensor rotor.
(b) Place the skid control sensor on the rear axle hub so that
the connector makes the lowest position under the onvehicle condition.
RH:
Connector
F45440
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3155
32-43
BRAKE
-
SKID CONTROL SENSOR (FF)
(c)
SST
F45370
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
(a)
14.
15.
16.
Using SST and a press, install the skid control sensor
onto the hub & bearing assy.
SST 09214-7601 1
NOTICE:
Do not tap the skid control sensor with a hammer directly.
Check that there is no foreign matter on the skid control sensor detection portion.
Press in the skid control sensor straight and slowly.
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-53 )
INSPECT BEARING BACKLASH (SEE PAGE 30-53 )
INSPECT AXLE HUB DEVIATION (SEE PAGE 30-53 )
INSTALL REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 30-53 )
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-53 )
CONNECT SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
Connect the connector to the skid control sensor.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT AND ADJUST REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 27-5 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3156
32-8
BRAKE
-
BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSY
BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSY
3203C-05
ADJUSTMENT
1.
(a)
Stop Lamp Switch
Lock Nut
(b)
Stop Lamp
Switch Assy
Push Rod
Push Rod
Lock Nut
F45502
Pedal Height
F47533
CHECK AND ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL HEIGHT
Check brake pedal height.
Pedal height from asphalt sheet:
150 to 160 mm (5.906 to 6.299 in.)
Adjust brake pedal height.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the stop lamp switch
assy.
(2) Loosen the stop lamp switch lock nut and remove
the stop lamp switch assy.
(3) Loosen the push rod lock nut.
(4) Adjust the pedal height by turning the pedal push
rod.
(5) Tighten the push rod lock nut.
Torque: 26 N⋅m (265 kgf⋅cm, 19 ft⋅lbf)
(6) Install the stop lamp switch assy.
(7) Connect the connector to the stop lamp switch assy.
(8) Push the brake pedal in 5 to 10 mm (0.20 to 0.39 in.)
and turn the stop lamp switch assy to lock the nut
in the position where the stop lamp goes off.
(9) After installation, push the brake pedal in 5 to 10
mm (0.20 to 0.39 in.), and check that the stop lamp
comes on.
(10) Tighten the stop lamp switch lock nut.
Torque: 17 N⋅m (173 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
2.
(a)
CHECK PEDAL FREE PLAY
Stop the engine and depress the brake pedal several
times until no vacuum remains in the booster.
(b) Press the pedal until resistance is felt. Measure the distance as shown in the illustration.
Pedal free play: 2.0 to 3.0 mm (0.079 to 0.118 in.)
If incorrect, proceed to the following step.
(1) Check the stop lamp switch clearance.
Stop lamp switch clearance:
0.5 to 2.6 mm (0.020 to 0.102 in.)
If the clearance is OK, then troubleshoot the brake system.
If incorrect, adjust the stop lamp switch clearance.
Pedal Free play
F45503
F47534
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3121
32-9
BRAKE
-
BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSY
3.
(a)
(b)
Pedal Reserve
Distance
CHECK PEDAL RESERVE DISTANCE
Release the parking brake pedal.
With engine running, depress the pedal and measure the
pedal reserve distance, as shown in the illustration.
Pedal reserve distance from asphalt sheet at 490 N
(50 kgf, 110.2 lbf): More than 83 mm (3.3 in.)
If incorrect, troubleshoot the brake system.
R00934
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3122
32-10
BRAKE
-
BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSY
320WD-03
COMPONENTS
20 (204, 15)
Brake Pedal Support Sub-assy
Brake Pedal Shaft
37 (375, 27)
Stop Lamp Switch Assy
Connector
17 (173, 13)
Stop Lamp Switch Lock Nut
13 (130, 9)
Brake Pedal Bush
Brake Pedal Bush
Brake Pedal Shaft Collar
Stop Lamp Switch Cushion
Brake Master Cylinder
Push Rod Clevis
Connector
Push Rod Pin
Clip
Brake Pedal Sub-assy
Brake Pedal
Return Spring
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
Brake Pedal Pad
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
F46190
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3123
32-1 1
BRAKE
-
BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSY
320WE-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
(a)
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY LOWER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL RETURN SPRING
Remove the brake pedal return spring.
Brake Master Cylinder Push Rod Clevis
Pedal Force Switch
Connector
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Clip
REMOVE PUSH ROD PIN
Remove the clip and the push rod pin.
Disconnect the stop lamp switch connector.
Disconnect the pedal force switch connector and release
the clip of the pedal force switch.
Push Rod Pin
F45787
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL GARNISH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
COMBINATION METER ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
9.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL SUPPORT ASSY
Nut
Bolt
(a) Remove the bolt, the 4 nuts and the brake pedal support
assy.
F46191
10.
(a)
11.
(a)
12.
(a)
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSY
Remove the nut, the brake pedal shaft and the brake pedal sub-assy from the brake pedal support
sub-assy .
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL PAD
Remove the brake pedal pad from the brake pedal sub-assy.
REMOVE STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
Loosen the stop lamp switch lock nut and remove the stop lamp switch assy.
13.
(a)
Shaft Collar
Pedal Bush
Pedal Bush
14.
(a)
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL BUSH
Remove the 2 brake pedal bushes from the brake pedal
sub-assy .
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL SHAFT COLLAR
Remove the brake pedal shaft collar from the brake pedal
sub-assy .
F45786
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3124
32-12
BRAKE
15.
(a)
16.
(a)
-
BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSY
REMOVE STOP LAMP SWITCH CUSHION
Remove the stop lamp switch cushion from the brake pedal sub-assy.
INSTALL STOP LAMP SWITCH CUSHION
Install the stop lamp switch cushion to the brake pedal sub-assy.
17.
(a)
Shaft Collar
Pedal Bush
(b)
Pedal Bush
Lithium soap base glycol grease
F45786
18.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL SHAFT COLLAR
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the ends and
sides of brake pedal shaft collar.
Install the brake pedal shaft collar to the brake pedal subassy.
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL BUSH
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the ends and
sides of 2 new brake pedal bushes.
Install the brake pedal bushes to the brake pedal subassy.
19. INSTALL STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
(a) Install the stop lamp switch assy with the stop lamp switch lock nut.
HINT:
After adjusting the brake pedal height, torque the lock nut.
20. INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL PAD
(a) Install the brake pedal pad to the brake pedal sub-assy.
21. INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSY
(a) Install the brake pedal sub-assy with the brake pedal shaft and the nut.
Torque: 37 N⋅m (375 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
Nut
22.
(a)
Bolt
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL SUPPORT ASSY
Install the brake pedal support assy with the bolt and the
4 nuts.
Torque:
Bolt: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Nut: 13 N⋅m (130 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
F46191
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
INSTALL COMBINATION METER ASSY
INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY
INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL GARNISH
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER
INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY CENTER
28. INSTALL PUSH ROD PIN
Brake Master Cylinder Push Rod Clevis
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the clevis pin.
(b) Install the clevis pin and the clip.
Pedal Force Switch
(c) Connect the pedal force switch connector and install the
Connector
clip of the pedal force switch to the brake pedal support
Clip
sub-assy .
Push Rod Pin
(d) Connect the stop lamp switch connector.
Lithium soap base glycol grease
F45787
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3125
32-13
BRAKE
29.
(a)
30.
31.
32.
33.
-
BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSY
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL RETURN SPRING
Install the brake pedal return spring.
CHECK AND ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL HEIGHT (SEE PAGE 32-8 )
CHECK PEDAL FREE PLAY (SEE PAGE 32-8 )
CHECK PEDAL RESERVE DISTANCE (SEE PAGE 32-8 )
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY LOWER
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3126
32-44
BRAKE
-
SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (4WD)
SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (4WD)
320WP-03
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
3.
REMOVE SPEED SENSOR REAR LH
(a) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the wire harness.
C95580
(b)
(b) Pull out the sensor wire harness with the grommet.
NOTICE:
Do not pull sensor wire.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts holding the sensor harness from the
body and the shock absorber assy.
(c)
(c)
G23207
(d) Remove the bolt and the speed sensor rear.
NOTICE:
Prevent foreign matter from attaching to the sensor tip.
G23208
4.
(a)
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR LH
Install the speed sensor rear with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Prevent foreign matter from attaching to the sensor tip.
G23208
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3157
32-45
BRAKE
-
SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (4WD)
(b)
G23207
Install the sensor harness clamps with the 2 bolts to the
body and the shock absorber assy.
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not twist the sensor wire when installing the sensor.
(c) Push in the sensor wire harness with grommet.
NOTICE:
When grommet is set to body, pull the grommet. Do not pull
sensor wire.
(d)
Connect the speed sensor connector.
C95580
5.
6.
7.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSY LH
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3158
32-46
BRAKE
-
YAWRATE SENSOR
YAWRATE SENSOR
320WQ-03
REPLACEMENT
NOTICE:
Do not use the yawrate sensor if it is dropped or damaged.
Prevent foreign matter from attaching between the yawrate sensor bracket and body.
Confirm the sensor direction is correct.
1.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH (SEE PAGE 72-1 1 or 72-19 )
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
3.
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
4.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
5.
REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
6.
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
7.
(a)
REMOVE YAWRATE SENSOR PROTECTOR
Remove the bolt and the sensor protector.
G23199
8.
REMOVE YAWRATE SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and the yawrate sensor.
NOTICE:
Do not remove the yawrate sensor from the yawrate sensor
bracket.
G23200
9.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL YAWRATE SENSOR
Install the yawrate sensor with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 14 N⋅m (143 kgf⋅cm, 10 ft.⋅lbf)
Connect the connector.
G23200
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3159
32-47
BRAKE
10.
(a)
-
YAWRATE SENSOR
INSTALL YAWRATE SENSOR PROTECTOR
Install the sensor protector with the bolt.
Torque: 14 N⋅m (143 kgf⋅cm, 10 ft.⋅lbf)
G23199
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER RH
INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH
INSTALL FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH (SEE PAGE 72-1 1 or 72-19 )
PERFORM YAWRATE SENSOR ZERO POINT CALIBRATION (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
CHECK IN THE TEST MODE (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3160
32-48
BRAKE
-
STEERING SENSOR
STEERING SENSOR
320WR-05
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
REMOVE HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSY (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010, 09953-05020, 09954-05021)
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER UPR (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-26 )
8.
(a)
Claw
Claw
F45898
9.
INSTALL STEERING SENSOR
(a) Install the steering sensor to the spiral cable.
NOTICE:
Install the claw securely.
Do not damage the claw.
Claw
Claw
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
REMOVE STEERING SENSOR
Release 6 claw fittings and remove the steering sensor
from the spiral cable.
F45898
ADJUST CENTER FRONT WHEEL
INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-26 )
CENTER SPIRAL CABLE (SEE PAGE 60-26 )
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSY (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
INSTALL HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
INSPECT STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
INSPECT HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-1 1)
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3161
33-2
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
330CI-04
ADJUSTMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
Strongly step on the parking brake pedal.
Release the parking brake.
Once more, slowly depress the parking brake pedal all the way, and count the number of clicks.
Parking brake pedal travel: 5 to 7 clicks at 300 N (31 kgf, 67.46 lbf)
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Lock Nut
(d)
(e)
Parking Brake
Adjusting Nut
(f)
G24942
(g)
(h)
(i)
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
Remove the instrument panel finish panel sub-assy lower.(see page 71-10 )
Remove the instrument PNL insert sub- assy LWR
LH.(see page 71-10 )
Depress the parking brake pedal 5 clicks to make room
for the procedure, and loosen the lock nut with fixing adjusting nut by wrench.
Release the parking brake pedal to the original position.
Turn the paking brake wire adjusting nut until the parking
brake pedal travel is correct.
Using a spanner or equivalent to hold the parking brake
adjusting nut, tighten the lock nut.
Torque: 6.0 N⋅m (61 kgf⋅cm, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Count the number of clicks after depressing and canceling the parking brake pedal 3 to 4 times.
Check whether the parking brake drags or not.
When operating the parking brake pedal, check that the
parking brake pedal indicator light is lit.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3163
33-1
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
330CH-04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely cause
of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
1. Parking brake pedal travel (Out of adjustment)
2. Parking brake wire (Sticking)
Brake drag
3. Parking brake shoe clearance (Out of adjustment)
4. Parking brake shoe lining (Cracked or distorted)
5. Tension or return spring (Damaged)
33-2
33-10
33-14
33-19
33-19
33-19
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3162
33-3
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
330CL-04
COMPONENTS
Parking Brake Pedal Assy
39 (400, 29)
Parking Brake Switch Assy
Clip
39 (400, 29)
Parking Brake Wire
Adjusting Nut No.1
39 (400, 29)
Parking Pedal Pad
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Lock Nut
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.1
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
F46471
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3164
33-4
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
8.5 (87, 75 in.⋅lbf)
FR Floor Footrest
Parking Brake Equalizer
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.1
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
F45547
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3165
33-5
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
330FC-01
OVERHAUL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
(a)
PRECAUTION (W/ SIDE AIRBAG) (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY LOWER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PNL INSERT SUB-ASSY LWR LH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER RH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER LH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
DISCONNECT TURN SIGNAL FLASHER ASSY
REMOVE FR FLOOR FOOTREST
Remove the front floor footrest from the floor.
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
Disconnect the connectors.
Remove the 2 nuts.
Separate the instrument panel junction block assy.
Release the parking brake pedal to the original position.
Remove the 2 bolts and nuts, and separate the parking
brake cable assy No.1 from the floor.
F46488
Nut
Nut
Bolt
F46472
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3166
33-6
PARKING BRAKE
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
-
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
Remove the parking brake cable assy No.1 from the parking brake equalizer.
Disconnect the parking brake switch connector.
Remove the 3 nuts and separate the instrument panel
junction block assy w/ bracket from the body.
Remove the 3 nuts and parking brake control pedal assy.
F46473
14.
15.
(a)
16.
(a)
17.
(a)
18.
(a)
19.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1 (SEE PAGE 33-10 )
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSY
Remove the screw and parking brake switch assy.
REMOVE PARKING PEDAL PAD
Remove the parking pedal pad.
INSTALL PARKING PEDAL PAD
Install the parking pedal pad.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSY
Install the parking brake switch assy with the screw.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1 (SEE PAGE 33-10 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3167
33-7
PARKING BRAKE
20.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
-
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
Install the parking brake control pedal assy with the 3
nuts.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the parking brake switch connector.
Connect the instrument panel junction block assy w/
bracket with the 3 nuts.
Attach the parking brake cable assy No.1 to the parking
brake equalizer and slide boot stopper of No.1 cable
should be inserted into groove of T-Metal fitting.
Install the parking brake cable assy No.1 with the 2 bolts
and 2 nuts.
Torque:
Bolt: 8.5 N⋅m (87 kgf⋅cm, 75 in.⋅lbf)
Nut: 6.0 N⋅m (61 kgf⋅cm, 53 in.⋅lbf)
F46473
Slide Boot
Nut
Nut
Bolt
F46472
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3168
33-8
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
(f)
Install the instrument panel junction block assy with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 7.3 N⋅m (74 kgf⋅cm, 65 in.⋅lbf)
(g)
Connect the connectors.
F46488
21.
(a)
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
INSTALL FR FLOOR FOOTREST
Install the front floor footrest on the floor.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (W/ SIDE AIRBAG) (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3169
33-9
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
330CN-04
COMPONENTS
Parking Brake Pedal Assy
39 (400, 29)
Clip
39 (400, 29)
Parking Brake Wire
Adjusting Nut No.1
Lock Nut
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
39 (400, 29)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
8.5 (87, 75 in.⋅lbf)
FR Floor Footrest
Parking Brake Equalizer
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.1
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
F46475
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3170
33-10
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
330CO-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
PRECAUTION (W/ SIDE AIRBAG) (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY LOWER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PNL INSERT SUB-ASSY LWR LH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER RH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER LH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FR FLOOR FOOTREST (SEE PAGE 33-5 )
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY (SEE PAGE 33-5 )
13. REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the parking brake cable assy
No.1.
G24943
Parking Brake
Wire Adjusting
Nut No.1
(b)
(c)
Remove the clip from the parking brake pedal assy.
Remove the lock nut and parking brake wire adjusting nut
No.1.
14.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
Install the parking brake cable assy No.1 with the clip.
Temporarily install the parking brake wire adjusting nut
No.1 and lock nut.
Clip
Lock Nut
G24944
Parking Brake Wire
Adjusting Nut No.1
Clip
Lock Nut
G24944
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3171
33-1 1
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
(c) Bend the claw.
NOTICE:
Bend the claw fully.
G24943
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY (SEE PAGE 33-5 )
INSTALL FR FLOOR FOOTREST (SEE PAGE 33-5 )
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (W/ SIDE AIRBAG) (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3172
33-12
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
330CP-04
COMPONENTS
FF:
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.2
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.3
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
39 (400, 29)
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
39 (400, 29)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
8.5 (87, 75 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket No.1
Parking Brake Equalizer
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
G24937
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3173
33-13
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
4WD:
Rear Axle Hub & Bearing Assy RH
75 (765, 55)
Rear Axle Shaft Nut
294 (3,000, 217)
Parking Brake Hole RH
75 (765, 55)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Speed Sensor RR RH
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.2
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.3
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
39 (400, 29)
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
39 (400, 29)
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket No.1
8.5 (87, 75 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Equalizer
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Rear Axle Hub & Bearing Assy LH
Speed Sensor RR LH
Rear Axle Shaft Nut
294 (3,000, 217)
75 (765, 55)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Hole LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
75 (765, 55)
G24939
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3174
33-14
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
330CQ-04
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
For parking brake cable No.2, employ the same procedure to the No.3 side.
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and separate the rear disc brake caliper assy LH.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the rear brake caliper assy LH.
3.
REMOVE REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
4.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION SPRING (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
5.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
6.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.1 (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
7.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ADJUSTING SCREW SET (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
8.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.2 (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
9.
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
10. REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
11. REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
12.
(a)
FF:
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
Remove the 2 bolts and separate the parking brake cable
assy No.3 from the backing plate.
4WD:
F45450
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3175
33-15
PARKING BRAKE
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
Remove the 4 nuts and 2 bolts and separate the parking
brake cable assy No.3 from the body.
Separate the parking brake cable assy No.3 from the
equalizer and remove the parking brake cable assy No.3.
Remove the parking brake cable support bracket No.1
from the parking brake cable assy No.3.
Bolt A
Nut
Nut
Bolt B
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket No.1
Nut
G24918
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
Attach the parking brake cable support bracket No.1 to the parking brake cable assy No.3.
Connect the parking brake cable assy No.3 to the equalizer and slide boot stopper of No.1 cable should
be inserted into groove of T-Metal fitting.
Install the 4 nuts, 2 bolts and parking brake cable assy No.3 to the body.
Torque:
Bolt A: 8.5 N⋅m (87 kgf⋅cm, 75 in.⋅lbf)
Bolt B: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
Nut: 6.0 N⋅m (61 kgf⋅cm, 53 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3176
33-16
PARKING BRAKE
(d)
FF:
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
Connect the parking brake cable assy No.3 to the backing
plate with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
4WD:
F45450
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
(a)
27.
28.
(a)
29.
30.
31.
32.
APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.2 (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ADJUSTING SCREW SET (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.1 (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION SPRING (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
CHECK PARKING BRAKE INSTALLATION (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSPECT BEARING BACKLASH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
INSPECT AXLE HUB DEVIATION (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
INSTALL REAR DISC
Aligning the matchmarks, install the rear disc.
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
CONNECT REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Install the rear disc brake caliper assy LH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 78 N⋅m (800 kgf⋅cm, 58 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3177
33-17
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
330CR-03
COMPONENTS
FF:
Parking Brake Shoe Strut LH
Rear Disc Brake Caliper Assy LH
Parking Brake Shoe
Strut Compression Spring
Parking Brake Shoe
Assy LH No.2
78 (800, 58)
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring Pin No.2
Parking Brake Shoe Hold Down
Spring Cup No.2
Parking Brake Shoe Return
Tension Spring No.1
Shim
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring
C-W asher
Parking Brake Shoe Lever
Parking Brake Shoe Hold Down
Spring Cup No.1
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring Pin No.1
Parking Brake
Shoe Assy LH No.1
Parking Brake Shoe
Adjusting Screw Set
Parking Brake Shoe
Return Tension Spring No.2
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring Cup No.2
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring
Parking Brake Shoe Hold Down
Spring Cup No.1
Rear Disc
Parking Brake Shoe
Adjusting Hole Plug
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
High Temperature grease
F47274
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3178
33-18
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
4WD:
Speed Sensor RR LH
Rear Disc Brake Caliper Assy LH
78 (800, 58)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Shoe
Strut Compression Spring
78 (800, 58)
Parking Brake Shoe Strut LH
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring Pin No.2
Parking Brake Shoe
Assy LH No.2
Parking Brake Shoe Return
Tension Spring No.1
C-W asher
Parking Brake Shoe Hold Down
Spring Cup No.2
Shim
Parking Brake Shoe Lever
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring
Parking Brake Shoe Hold Down
Spring Cup No.1
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring
Pin No.1
75 (765, 55)
Parking Brake Shoe
Assy LH No.1
Rear Axle Shaft Nut
294 (3,000, 217)
Parking Brake Shoe
ReturnTension Spring No.2
Parking Brake Shoe
Adjusting Screw Set
75 (765, 55)
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring Cup No.2
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
High Temperature grease
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring
Rear Disc
Rear Axle
Hub & Bearing Assy LH
Parking Brake Shoe
Adjusting Hole Plug
F47275
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3179
33-19
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
330CS-04
OVERHAUL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Remove the 2 bolts and separate the rear disc brake caliper assy LH.
1.
2.
(a)
HINT:
Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the disc brake caliper assy LH.
3.
REMOVE REAR DISC
(a) Release the parking brake, and remove the rear disc.
HINT:
If the disc cannot be removed easily, turn the shoe adjuster until
the wheel turns freely.
Contract
D28126
(b)
(c)
Machmarks
Place machmarks on the rear disc and the axle hub.
Remove the rear disc.
F41543
4.
(a)
INSPECT BRAKE DISC INSIDE DIAMETER
Using a brake drum gauge or equivalent tool, measure
the inside diameter of the rear disc.
Standard inside diameter: 190 mm (7.480 in.)
Maximum inside diameter: 191 mm (7.520 in.)
If the inside diameter exceeds the maximum, replace the brake
disc.
F06409
5.
(a)
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION
SPRING
Using needle-nose pliers, remove the 2 parking brake
shoe return tension springs No.1.
D28127
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3180
33-20
PARKING BRAKE
6.
(a)
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH
Remove the parking brake shoe strut LH and the parking brake shoe strut compression spring.
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
G25968
8.
Adjusting Screw Set
(a)
(b)
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.1
Remove the parking brake shoe hold down spring cup
No.1, parking brake shoe hold down spring and parking
brake shoe hold down spring cup No.2.
FF:
Remove the parking brake shoe hold down spring pin
No.1.
Disconnect the parking brake shoe return spring No.2
and remove the parking brake shoe assy LH No.1.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ADJUSTING
SCREW SET
Remove the parking brake shoe adjusting screw set.
Remove the parking brake shoe return tension spring
No.2.
Return tension Spring
F45549
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.2
Remove the parking brake shoe hold down spring cup
No.1, parking brake shoe hold down spring, parking
brake shoe hold down spring cup No.2 and parking brake
shoe hold down spring pin No.2.
Remove the parking brake shoe assy LH No.2.
G25969
(c)
Using needle-nose pliers, disconnect the parking brake
cable No.3 from the parking brake cable shoe lever.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage parking brake cable No.3.
R00310
10.
11.
12.
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
SST 09930-00010
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3181
33-21
PARKING BRAKE
13.
(a)
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE HOLD DOWN
SPRING PIN (4WD DRIVE TYPE)
Remove the parking brake shoe hold down spring pin
No.1.
G24920
14.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE TYPE C WASHER
Using a screwdriver, remove the C-washer.
Remove the shim and parking brake shoe lever from
parking brake shoe assy LH No.2.
F41058
15.
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SHOE LINING
THICKNESS
(a) Using a ruler, measure the thickness of the shoe lining.
Standard thickness: 2.5 mm (0.098 in.)
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the lining thickness is less than or equal to the minimum, or
if there is severe or uneven wear, replace the brake shoe.
R00311
16.
INSPECT BRAKE DISC AND PARKING BRAKE SHOE
LINING FOR PROPER CONTACT
(a) Apply chalk to the inside surface of the disc, then grind
down the brake shoe lining to fit disc.
If the contact between the brake disc and the shoe lining is improper, repair it using a brake shoe grinder or replace the brake
shoe assembly.
BR0828
17.
(a)
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE TYPE C WASHER
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard clearance: Less than 0.35 mm (0.014 in.)
If the clearance is not within the specifications, replace the shim
with one of the correct size.
Shim Thickness
Shim Thickness
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
-
R00343
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3182
33-22
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
(b)
Using pliers, install the parking brake shoe lever LH and
the shim with a new C-washer.
18.
(a)
APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE
Apply high temperature grease to the shaded parts
shown in the illustration of the backing plate which make
contact with the shoe.
19.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE HOLD DOWN
SPRING PIN (4WD DRIVE TYPE)
Install the parking brake shoe hold down spring pin No.1.
C64144
High Temperature Grease
C97930
(a)
G24920
20.
21.
22.
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
23.
(a)
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.2
Using needle-nose pliers, connect the parking brake
cable No.3 to the parking brake cable shoe lever.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the parking brake cable No.3.
R00310
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3183
33-23
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
(b)
Install the parking brake shoe assy LH No.2 with the parking brake shoe hold down spring, parking brake shoe hold
down spring cup No.1, parking brake shoe hold down
spring cup No.2 and parking brake shoe hold down spring
pin No.2.
24.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ADJUSTING
SCREW SET
Apply high temperature grease to the parking brake shoe
adjusting bolt and piece.
G25969
(a)
Piece
Adjusting Bolt
High Temperature Grease
F41705
(b)
Adjusting
Screw
Set
Return
tension
Spring
(c)
Adjusting Screw Set
Attach the parking brake shoe return tension spring No.2
to parking brake shoe assy LH No.1 and parking brake
shoe assy LH No.2.
Attach the parking brake shoe adjusting screw set to the
parking brake shoe assy LH No.1 and parking brake shoe
assy LH No.2.
F45550
25.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.1
FF:
Install the parking brake shoe hold down spring pin No.1.
Install the parking brake shoe assy LH No.1 with the parking brake shoe hold down spring, parking brake shoe hold
down spring cup No.2, parking brake shoe hold down
spring cup No.2.
G25968
26.
(a)
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH
Attach the parking brake shoe strut LH and the parking brake shoe strut compression spring to parking
brake shoe assy LH No.2 and parking brake shoe assy LH No.1.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3184
33-24
PARKING BRAKE
27.
(a)
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION
SPRING
Using needle-nose pliers, install the 2 return tension
springs No.1 as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
First install the front side spring then the rear side spring.
D28127
28. CHECK PARKING BRAKE INSTALLATION
(a) Check that each part is installed properly.
NOTICE:
There should be no oil or grease on the friction surface of
the shoe lining and disc.
RH
Front
C88601
29.
30.
31.
(a)
LH
Front
F45453
INSPECT BEARING BACKLASH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
INSPECT AXLE HUB DEVIATION (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
INSTALL REAR DISC
Aligning the matchmarks, install the rear disc.
32.
(a)
(b)
Expand
(c)
(d)
(e)
Contract
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE
Temporarily install the hub nuts.
Remove the hole plug, turn the adjuster and expand the
shoes until the disc locks.
Contract the shoe adjuster until the disc rotates smoothly.
Standard : Return 8 notches
Check that the shoe has no brake drag.
Install the hole plug.
F45452
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3185
33-25
PARKING BRAKE
33.
(a)
34.
35.
36.
37.
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
CONNECT REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Install the rear disc brake caliper assy LH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 78 N⋅m (800 kgf⋅cm, 58 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3186
32-4
BRAKE
-
BRAKE FLUID
BRAKE FLUID
320WC-05
BLEEDING
HINT:
If any work is performed on the brake system or if air in the brake lines is suspected, bleed the air out of the
brake system.
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any painted surface.
1.
Brake Fluid
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
Fluid: SAE J1703 or FMVSS No. 116 DOT3
F46187
2.
BLEED MASTER CYLINDER
HINT:
If the master cylinder has been disassembled or if the reservoir
becomes empty, bleed the air out of the master cylinder.
(a) Using SST, disconnect the brake lines from the master
cylinder.
SST 09023-00101
(b) Slowly depress and hold the brake pedal.
F46188
(c)
(d)
(e)
Cover the outer holes with your fingers, and release the
brake pedal.
Repeat (b) and (c) 3 or 4 times.
Using SST, connect the brake lines from the master cylinder.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N⋅m (155 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
F46189
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
C80826
(e)
BLEED BRAKE LINE
Connect the vinyl tube to the bleeder plug.
Depress the brake pedal several times, then loosen the
bleeder plug with the pedal depressed.
At the point when fluid stops coming out, tighten the
bleeder plug, then release the brake pedal.
Repeat (b) and (c) until all the air in the fluid is completely
bled out.
Tighten the bleeder plug completely.
Torque: 8.3 N⋅m (85 kgf⋅cm, 73 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3117
32-5
BRAKE
-
BRAKE FLUID
(f)
Hand-held Tester
DLC3
G23361
Repeat the previous procedures for each wheel to bleed
the air out of the brake line.
4.
BLEED BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY
NOTICE:
After bleeding the air from the brake system, if the height
or feel of the brake pedal cannot be obtained, perform air
bleeding in the brake actuator assy with a hand-held tester
by following the procedures below.
(a) Depress the brake pedal more than 20 times with the engine off.
(b) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3, then turn the
ignition switch to the ON position.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(c) Select ”AIR BLEEDING” on the hand-held tester.
HINT:
Please refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(d) Bleed the air out of the regular brake line when ”Step 1:
Increase” appears on the hand-held tester display.
NOTICE:
Bleed the air by following the steps displayed on the
hand-held tester.
Make sure that the brake fluid in the master cylinder
reservoir tank does not become empty.
(1) Connect the vinyl tube to either one of the bleeder
plugs.
(2)
C80826
Depress the brake pedal several times, then loosen
the bleeder plug connected to the vinyl tube with the
pedal depressed.
(3) When fluid stops coming out, tighten the bleeder
plug and release the brake pedal.
(4) Repeat (2) and (3) until all the air in the fluid is completely bled out.
(5) Tighten the bleeder plug completely.
Torque: 8.3 N⋅m (85 kgf⋅cm, 73 in.⋅lbf)
(6) Repeat the above procedures for each wheel to
bleed the air out of the brake line.
(e) Bleed the air out of the suction line when ”Step 2: Inhalation” appears on the hand-held tester display.
NOTICE:
Bleed the air by following the steps displayed on the
hand-held tester.
Make sure that the brake fluid in the master cylinder
reservoir tank does not become empty.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3118
32-6
BRAKE
(1)
(2)
F47332
F47333
BRAKE FLUID
Connect the vinyl tube to the bleeder plug at the
right front wheel or the right rear wheel and loosen
the bleeder plug.
Operate the brake actuator assy to bleed the air using the hand-held tester.
NOTICE:
This operation stops automatically after 4 seconds.
At this time, be sure to release the brake pedal.
(3) Check if the operation has stopped by referring to
the hand-held tester display.
(4) Repeat (2) and (3) until all air in the fluid is completely bled out.
(5) Tighten the bleeder plug completely.
Torque: 8.3 N⋅m (85 kgf⋅cm, 73 in.⋅lbf)
(6) Repeat the above procedures to bleed the air out of
the brake line for each wheel.
(f)
Bleed the air out of the pressure reduction line when ”Step
3: Decrease” appears on the hand-held tester display.
NOTICE:
Bleed the air by following the steps displayed on the
hand-held tester.
Make sure that the brake fluid in the master cylinder
reservoir tank does not become empty.
(1) Connect a vinyl tube to either one of the bleeder
plugs.
(2) Loosen the bleeder plug.
(3)
Hold
-
Using the hand-held tester, operate the brake actuator assy, completely depress the brake pedal
and keep it.
NOTICE:
The operation stops automatically after 4 seconds.
When performing this procedure continuously, set an
interval of at least 20 seconds.
When the operation is complete, the brake pedal goes
down slightly. This is a nomal phenomenon caused
when the solenoid opens.
During this procedure, the pedal will feel heavy, but
completely depress it so that the brake fluid comes
out from the bleeder plug.
Be sure to keep depressing the brake pedal. Do not
depress and release the pedal repeatedly.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3119
32-7
BRAKE
-
BRAKE FLUID
(4)
Release
F47334
Tighten the bleeder plug, then release the brake
pedal.
(5) Repeat (2) to (4) until all the air in the fluid is completely bled out.
(6) Tighten the bleeder plug completely.
Torque: 8.3 N⋅m (85 kgf⋅cm, 73 in.⋅lbf)
(7) Repeat the above procedures for each wheel to
bleed the air out of the brake line.
(g) Bleed the air out of the regular brake line again when
”Step 4: Increase” appears on the hand-held tester display.
NOTICE:
Bleed the air by following the steps displayed on the
hand-held tester.
Make sure that the brake fluid in the master cylinder
reservoir tank does not become empty.
(1) Connect the vinyl tube to either one of the bleeder
plugs.
(2)
C80826
5.
(a)
Depress the brake pedal several times, then loosen
the bleeder plug connected to the vinyl tube with the
pedal depressed.
(3) When fluid stops coming out, tighten the bleeder
plug, then release the brake pedal.
(4) Repeat (2) and (3) until all the air in the fluid is completely bled out.
(5) Tighten the bleeder plug completely.
Torque: 8.3 N⋅m (85 kgf⋅cm, 73 in.⋅lbf)
(6) Repeat the above procedures for each wheel to
bleed the air out of the brake line.
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
Check the fluid level and add fluid if necessary.
Fluid: SAE J1703 or FMVSS No. 116 DOT3
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3120
32-14
BRAKE
-
BRAKE MASTER W/PLATE CYLINDER SUB-ASSY
BRAKE MASTER W/PLATE CYLINDER SUB-ASSY
320WF-05
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 32-18 .
1.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY
UPPER CENTER
Remove the 4 nuts and the front suspension brace subassy upper center.
F46629
2.
3.
4.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-24 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 14-149 )
5.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CASE (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
6.
DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any painted surface.
7.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE BRAKE MASTER W/PLATE CYLINDER
SUB-ASSY
Using SST, disconnect the 2 brake tubes from the brake
master w/plate cylinder sub-assy.
SST 09023-00101
Disconnect the brake fluid level warning switch connector.
F46630
(c)
Remove the 2 nuts, then pull at the check valve bracket
and the brake master w/plate cylinder assy.
F46631
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3127
32-15
BRAKE
-
BRAKE MASTER W/PLATE CYLINDER SUB-ASSY
8.
INSPECT AND ADJUST BRAKE BOOSTER PUSH
ROD
NOTICE:
Make an adjustment with the brake booster assy having no
vacuum. (Depress the brake pedal several times with the
engine stopped.)
HINT:
Adjustment of the brake booster push rod is performed when
the brake master cylinder sub-assy is replaced with a new one.
The adjustment is not necessary when the brake master cylinder sub-assy is reinstalled and the brake booster assy is replaced with a new one.
(a) Apply the chalk to the tip of an accessory tool.
HINT:
An accessory tool is enclosed with a new brake master cylinder
sub-assy .
(b)
(c)
Accessory Tool
F47053
HINT:
Adjust the clearance in following cases:
If there is a clearance between the accessory tool and the
shell of the brake booster (floating accessory tool), the
push rod is protruding too far.
If the chalk does not stick on the tip of the brake booster
push rod, the push rod protrusion is insufficient.
(d)
SST
Place the accessory tool to the brake booster assy.
Measure the clearance between the brake booster push
rod and accessory tool.
Clearance: 0 mm (0 in.)
If clearance is outside the specified range, fix the push rod
using SST and adjust the length of the protruding adjusting bolt.
SST 09737-00020
HINT:
When adjusting the push rod, depress the brake pedal sufficiently so that the push rod sticks out.
F40006
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3128
32-16
BRAKE
9.
(a)
-
BRAKE MASTER W/PLATE CYLINDER SUB-ASSY
INSTALL BRAKE MASTER W/PLATE CYLINDER
SUB-ASSY
Install the brake master w/ plate cylinder sub-assy and
the check valve bracket with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 13 N⋅m (130 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
F46631
(b)
(c)
Using SST, connect the 2 brake tubes to the brake master
w/ plate cylinder assy.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N⋅m (155 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the brake fluid level warning switch connector.
F46630
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
BLEED MASTER CYLINDER (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
SST 09023-00101
BLEED BRAKE LINE (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
BLEED BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-24 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CASE (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 14-149 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
19.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY
UPPER CENTER
Install the front suspension brace sub-assy upper center
with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 80 N⋅m (816 kgf⋅cm, 59 ft⋅lbf)
F46629
20.
21.
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3129
32-18
BRAKE
-
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSY
320WG-04
COMPONENTS
Clamp
Clamp
Front Brake Tube No.6
15 (155, 11)
Front Brake Tube No.7
Brake Master Cylinder
Push Rod Clevis
15 (155, 11)
Vacuum Hose
Brake Vacuum
Check Valve Assy
Clip
Push Rod Pin
Grommet
Check Valve
Bracket
Push Rod Lock Nut
Clip
26 (265, 19 )
13 (130, 9)
13 (130, 9)
Brake Booster Gasket
O-ring
Brake Pedal
Return Spring
Brake Booster Assy
13 (130, 9)
Brake Master w/Plate
Cylinder Sub-assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
F47750
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3131
32-17
BRAKE
-
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSY
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSY
3203F-11
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
GOOD
1st
2nd
1.
(a)
NO GOOD
3rd
BR2238
HINT:
If the pedal can be depressed (to the floor) the first time, but
cannot be depressed as far on the 2nd or 3rd time, the booster
is airtight.
(2) Depress the brake pedal while the engine is running, and stop the engine with the pedal depressed.
HINT:
If there is no change in the pedal reserve distance while holding
the pedal for 30 seconds, the booster is airtight.
(b)
BR2237
Ventilation
No Ventilation
INSPECT BRAKE BOOSTER
Airtightness check.
(1) Start the engine and stop it after 1 or 2 minutes. Depress the brake pedal several times slowly.
Operating check.
(1) Depress the brake pedal several times with the ignition switch off and check that there is no change in
the pedal reserve distance.
(2) Start the engine with the brake pedal depressed.
HINT:
If the pedal goes down slightly, operation is normal.
2.
INSPECT VACUUM CHECK VALVE
(a) Check vacuum check valve.
(1) Slide the clip and disconnect the vacuum hose.
(2) Remove the vacuum check valve.
(3)
(4)
Check that there is ventilation from the booster to
engine, and no ventilation from the engine to the
booster.
If any fault is found, replace the vacuum check
valve.
F40007
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3130
32-19
BRAKE
-
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSY
3215Q-04
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER (SEE PAGE 32-14 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-24 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
REMOVE AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 14-149 )
5.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CASE (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
6.
DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any painted surface.
7.
REMOVE BRAKE MASTER W/PLATE CYLINDER SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-14 )
SST 09023-00101
8.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY LOWER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
9.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL RETURN SPRING
(a) Remove the brake pedal return spring.
Push Rod
Lock Nut
Brake Master Cylinder
Push Rod Clevis
10.
(a)
(b)
Clip
REMOVE BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER PUSH ROD
CLEVIS
Remove the clip and the push rod pin.
Loosen the push rod lock nut and remove the push rod
clevis.
Push Rod Pin
G24409
11.
(a)
SEPARATE BRAKE TUBE
Release the 2 claw fittings of the clamp and separate the
2 brake tubes from the body.
SST 09023-00101
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the brake tubes.
Clamp
Brake Tube
Front Side
To Master
Cylinder
F46633
12.
(a)
Clip
REMOVE BRAKE BOOSTER ASSY
Slide the clip and disconnect the vacuum hose from the
check valve assy.
Vacuum Hose
F47054
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3132
32-20
BRAKE
-
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSY
(b) Remove the 4 nuts and pull out the brake booster assy.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the brake tubes and the wire harness.
BR3753
13.
(a)
REMOVE BRAKE BOOSTER GASKET
Remove the brake booster gasket from the brake booster assy.
14.
(a)
Grommet
15.
(a)
Brake Vacuum
Check Valve Assy
REMOVE BRAKE VACUUM CHECK VALVE ASSY
Remove the check valve assy and the grommet from the
brake booster assy.
INSTALL BRAKE VACUUM CHECK VALVE ASSY
Install the grommet and the check valve assy to the brake
booster assy.
F45790
16.
(a)
INSTALL BRAKE BOOSTER GASKET
Install a new brake booster gasket to the brake booster assy.
17.
(a)
INSTALL BRAKE BOOSTER ASSY
Install the brake booster assy with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 13 N⋅m (130 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the brake tubes and the wire harness.
BR3753
(b)
Clip
Connect the vacuum hose to the brake booster assy and
slide the clip.
Vacuum Hose
F47054
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3133
32-21
BRAKE
-
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSY
18.
(a)
INSTALL BRAKE TUBE
Install the 2 clamps of the brake tube to the body.
SST 09023-00101
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the brake tubes.
Clamp
Brake Tube
Front Side
To Master
Cylinder
F46633
Push Rod
Lock Nut
Brake Master Cylinder
Push Rod Clevis
Clip
Push Rod Pin
Lithium soap base glycol grease
20.
(a)
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
19.
INSTALL BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER PUSH ROD
CLEVIS
Install the push rod clevis and the push rod lock nut.
(a)
HINT:
After adjusting the brake pedal height, torque the lock nut.
(b) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the clevis pin.
(c) Install the push rod pin and the clip.
G24409
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL RETURN SPRING
Install the brake pedal return spring.
INSPECT AND ADJUST BRAKE BOOSTER PUSH ROD (SEE PAGE 32-14 )
SST 09737-00020
INSTALL BRAKE MASTER W/PLATE CYLINDER SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-14 )
SST 09023-00101
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
BLEED MASTER CYLINDER (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
SST 09023-00101
BLEED BRAKE LINE (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
BLEED BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
CHECK AND ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL HEIGHT (SEE PAGE 32-8 )
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY LOWER
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSY (2AZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-24 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CASE (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE)
(SEE PAGE 14-149 )
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP SUB-ASSY (3MZ-FE ENGINE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION BRACE SUB-ASSY UPPER CENTER (SEE PAGE 32-14 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3134
32-22
BRAKE
-
FRONT BRAKE
FRONT BRAKE
3215R-01
COMPONENTS
Front Disc
Front Disc Brake Bleeder Plug Cap
Front Disc Brake Bleeder Plug
8.3 (85, 73 in.⋅lbf)
34 (350, 25)
Front Disc Brake Cylinder
Slide Pin (Upper)
Flexible Hose
Front Disc Brake
Cylinder Sub-assy
Front Disc Brake
Bush Dust Boot
Front Disc Brake Pad
Support Plate (No.1)
Gasket
107 (1,090, 79)
29 (300, 21)
Set Ring
Piston Seal
34 (350, 25)
Front Disc
Brake Piston
Cylinder Boot
Front Disc Brake Cylinder
Slide Pin (Lower)
Front Disc Brake Cylinder Slide Bush
Anti Squeal
Shim Kit Front
Pad Wear Indicator
Front Disc Brake
Bush Dust Boot
Front Disc Brake
Cylinder Mounting LH
Front Disc Brake Pad
Support Plate (No.2)
Disc Brake Pad Kit Front
Anti Squeal Shim Kit Front
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
Disc brake grease
F47535
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3135
32-23
BRAKE
-
FRONT BRAKE
3215S-03
OVERHAUL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any painted surface.
3.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SUB-ASSY
(a) Remove the union bolt and gasket from the disc brake cylinder sub-assy, then disconnect the flexible
hose.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and disc brake cylinder sub-assy.
4.
REMOVE DISC BRAKE PAD KIT FRONT (PAD ONLY)
(a) Remove the 2 brake pads with anti-squeal shim.
5.
REMOVE ANTI SQUEAL SHIM KIT FRONT
(a) Remove the anti-squeal shim and pad wear indicator plate from inner pad.
(b) Remove the anti-squeal shim from outer pad.
6.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT PLATE
(a) Remove the front disc brake pad support plate (No.1) and front disc brake pad support plate (No.2)
from the disk brake cylinder mounting LH.
7.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE PIN
(a) Remove the 2 front disc brake cylinder slide pins from the front disc brake cylinder mounting LH.
Front Disc Brake Cylinder Slide Bush
8.
(a)
Front Disc Brake
Cylinder Slide Pin (Lower)
9.
(a)
10.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE
BUSH
Using a screwdriver, remove the front disc brake cylinder
slide bush from the front disc brake cylinder slide pin (lower).
F45433
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE BUSH DUST BOOT
Remove the 2 front disc brake bush dust boots from the front disc brake cylinder mounting.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER MOUNTING LH
Remove the 2 bolts and front disc brake cylinder mounting LH.
11.
(a)
REMOVE CYLINDER BOOT
Using a screwdriver, remove the set ring and cylinder
boot.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the inner cylinder and cylinder groove.
R09298
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3136
32-24
BRAKE
-
FRONT BRAKE
12.
(a)
Shop Rag
C64095
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE PISTON
Place a piece of shop rag or equivalent between the front
disc brake piston and the front disc brake cylinder subassy.
(b) Use compressed air to remove the front disc brake piston
from the front disc brake cylinder sub-assy.
CAUTION:
Do not place your fingers in front of the piston when using
compressed air.
NOTICE:
Do not spatter the brake fluid.
13.
(a)
REMOVE PISTON SEAL
Using a screwdriver, remove the piston seal from the front
disc brake cylinder sub-assy.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the inner cylinder and cylinder groove.
G23223
14. REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG CAP
(a) Remove the front disc brake bleeder plug cap from the front disc brake bleeder plug.
15. REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG
(a) Remove the front disc brake bleeder plug from the front disc brake cylinder sub-assy.
16. INSPECT BRAKE CYLINDER AND PISTON
(a) Check the cylinder bore and front disc brake piston for rust or scoring.
If necessary, replace the front disc brake cylinder sub-assy and front disc brake piston.
17.
(a)
INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness: 12.7 mm (0.500 in.)
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the pad lining thickness is equal to the minimum thickness or
less, replace the brake pad.
R02951
18.
(a)
INSPECT FRONT DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT PLATE
Inspect the front disc brake pad support plate (No.1) and front disc brake pad support plate (No.2).
(1) Make sure that both have sufficient rebound, have no deformation, cracks or wear, and that all
rust and dirt is cleaned off.
If necessary, replace the brake pad support plate.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3137
32-25
BRAKE
-
FRONT BRAKE
19.
(a)
INSPECT DISC THICKNESS
Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness: 28.0 mm (1.102 in.)
Minimum thickness: 26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
If the disc thickness is less than the minimum, replace the disc.
F41542
20.
(a)
(b)
Matchmarks
REMOVE FRONT DISC
Put matchmarks on the disc and the axle hub.
Remove the disc.
F47749
21. INSTALL FRONT DISC
(a) Aligning the matchmarks, install the front disc.
HINT:
When replacing the disc with a new one, select the installation position where the front disc has the minimum
runout.
22. INSPECT DISC RUNOUT
(a) Temporarily fasten the disc with hub nuts.
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the disc runout 10 mm
(0.39 in.) away from the outer edge of the disc.
Maximum disc runout: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
(c) If the runout exceeds the maximum value, change the
installation positions of the disc and axle so that the runout will become minimal. If the runout exceeds the maxiC83569
mum even when the installation positions are changed,
check the bearing play in the axial direction and the axle
hub runout (see page 30-3 ). If the bearing play and the
axle hub runout are normal and if the disc thickness is not
within the specified range, shave the disc. If the disc thickness is less than the minimum, replace the disc.
23. TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN FRONT DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG
(a) Temporarily tighten the front disc brake bleeder plug to the front disc brake cylinder sub-assy.
24. INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG CAP
(a) Install the front disc brake bleeder plug cap to the front disc brake bleeder plug.
25. INSTALL PISTON SEAL
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to a new piston seal.
(b) Install the piston seal to the front disc brake cylinder sub-assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3138
32-26
BRAKE
-
FRONT BRAKE
26.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE PISTON
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the front disc
brake piston.
(b) Install the front disc brake piston to the front disc brake
cylinder sub-assy smoothly.
NOTICE:
Do not install the front disc brake piston forcibly in the front
disc brake cylinder sub-assy.
F45434
27.
(a)
INSTALL CYLINDER BOOT
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to a new cylinder
boot. Install the cylinder boot to the front disc brake cylinder sub-assy.
HINT:
Install the boot securely to the grooves of the cylinder and piston.
(b) Using a screwdriver, install a new set ring.
NOTICE:
C82871
Install the boot securely to the grooves of the cylinder
and piston.
Do not damage the cylinder boot.
28. INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER MOUNTING LH
(a) Install the front disc brake cylinder mounting LH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 107 N⋅m (1,090 kgf⋅cm, 79 ft⋅lbf)
29. INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE BUSH DUST BOOT
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to seal surface of 2 new front disc brake bush dust boots.
(b) Install the 2 front disc brake bush dust boots to the front disc brake cylinder mounting LH.
30. INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE BUSH
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to a new front disc brake cylinder slide bush.
(b) Install the front disc brake cylinder slide bush to the front disc brake cylinder slide pin (lower).
31. INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE PIN
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the sliding part and the seal surface of the 2 front disc brake
cylinder slide pins.
(b) Install the 2 front disc brake cylinder slide pins to the front disc brake cylinder mounting LH.
NOTICE:
Insert the slide pin with slide bush into the lower side.
32. INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT PLATE
(a) Install the front disc brake pad support plate (No.1) and front disc brake pad support plate (No.2) to
the front disc brake cylinder mounting LH.
33. INSTALL ANTI SQUEAL SHIM KIT FRONT
NOTICE:
If necessary, replace the anti squeal shim kit when replacing the brake pad.
Install the shims in the correct position and direction.
(a) Apply disc brake grease to inside of each anti-squeal shim.
(b) Install anti-squeal shims on each pad.
(c) Install the pad wear indicator plate to the inner pad.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3139
32-27
BRAKE
-
FRONT BRAKE
34. INSTALL DISC BRAKE PAD KIT FRONT (PAD ONLY)
(a) Install the inner pad with the pad wear indicator plate facing upward, and install the outer pad.
NOTICE:
There should be no oil or grease on the friction surface of the pads and the disc.
35. INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SUB-ASSY
(a) Install the front disc brake cylinder sub-assy with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 34 N⋅m (350 kgf⋅cm, 25 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install a new gasket and flexible hose with the union bolt.
Torque: 29 N⋅m (300 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Install the flexible hose lock securely in the lock hole in the disc brake cylinder.
36. FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
37. BLEED MASTER CYLINDER (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
SST 09023-00101
38. BLEED BRAKE LINE (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
39. BLEED BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
40. CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
41. CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
42. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3140
32-28
BRAKE
-
REAR BRAKE
REAR BRAKE
320E7-05
COMPONENTS
Rear Disc Brake
Bleeder Plug Cap
Rear LH
Flexible Hose
Rear Disc Brake Cylinder Slide Pin
43 (440, 32)
Union Bolt
Rear Disc Brake Bleeder Plug
29 (300, 21)
8.3 (85, 73 in.⋅lbf)
Disc Brake
Cylinder Assy Rear LH
Gasket
Rear Disc Brake
Bush Dust Boot
Rear Disc Brake
Cylinder Slide Pin No.2
43 (440, 32)
Anti Squeal
Shim No.1
Rear Disc Brake Piston
Rear Disc Brake
Cylinder Slide Bush
Cylinder Boot
Piston Seal
Anti Squeal
Shim No.2
Rear Disc Brake
Pad Support Plate (No.1)
Rear Disc Brake Pad
Rear Disc Brake
Pad Support Plate (No.2)
Rear Disc Brake Pad
78 (800, 58)
Pad Wear Indicator
Rear Disc Brake
Cylinder Mounting LH
Pad Wear Indicator
Rear Disc
Anti Squeal
Shim No.1
Anti Squeal
Shim No.2
Parking Brake Shoe
Adjusting Hole Plug
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
Disc brake grease
F45443
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3141
32-29
BRAKE
-
REAR BRAKE
320WK-05
OVERHAUL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any painted surface.
3.
DISCONNECT REAR LH FLEXIBLE HOSE
(a) Remove the union bolt and gasket from the rear disc brake cylinder, then disconnect the flexible hose
from the rear disc brake cylinder.
Slide Pin
4.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE PIN
Remove the rear disc brake cylinder slide pin and rear
disc brake cylinder slide pin No.2.
5.
(a)
REMOVE DISC BRAKE CYLINDER ASSY REAR LH
Remove the disc brake cylinder assy rear LH.
Slide Pin No.2
G21633
F45897
6.
(a)
7.
(a)
(b)
8.
(a)
REMOVE DISC BRAKE PAD KIT REAR (PAD ONLY)
Remove the 2 brake pads with the anti squeal shim.
REMOVE ANTI SQUEAL SHIM KIT REAR
Remove the 4 anti squeal shims from each pad.
Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 pad wear indicators from each pad.
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT PLATE
Remove the rear disc brake pad support plate (No.1) and the rear disc brake pad support plate (No.2)
from the rear disc brake cylinder mounting LH.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3142
32-30
BRAKE
Rear Disc Brake Cylinder Mounting
-
REAR BRAKE
9.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE BUSH DUST BOOT
Remove the 2 rear disc brake bush dust boots from the
rear disc brake cylinder mounting LH.
10.
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE CYLINDER MOUNTING
LH
Remove the 2 bolts and the rear disc brake cylinder
mounting LH.
Bush Dust Boot
F45436
(a)
G21636
11.
Cylinder Slide Bush
Cylinder Slide Pin No.2
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE
BUSH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the rear disc brake cylinder
slide bush from the rear disc brake cylinder slide pin No.2.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the front disc brake cylinder slide pin No.2.
F45430
12. REMOVE CYLINDER BOOT
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the cylinder boot.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the inner cylinder and cylinder groove.
F45444
13.
(a)
Shop Rag
C95599
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE PISTON
Place a shop rag between the rear disc brake piston and
the disc brake cylinder assy rear LH.
(b) Use compressed air to remove the rear disc brake piston
from the disc brake cylinder assy rear LH.
CAUTION:
Do not place your fingers in front of the brake piston when
using compressed air.
NOTICE:
Do not spatter the brake fluid.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3143
32-31
BRAKE
-
REAR BRAKE
14.
(a)
REMOVE PISTON SEAL
Using a screwdriver, remove the piston seal from the disc
brake cylinder assy rear LH.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the inner cylinder and the cylinder groove.
G23223
15. REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG CAP
(a) Remove the rear disc brake bleeder plug cap from the rear disc brake bleeder plug.
16. REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG
(a) Remove the rear disc brake bleeder plug from the disc brake cylinder assy rear LH.
17. INSPECT BRAKE CYLINDER AND PISTON
(a) Inspect the cylinder bore and the brake piston for rust or scoring.
If necessary, replace the brake cylinder and piston.
18.
(a)
INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness: 10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the pad lining thickness is equal to the minimum thickness or
less, replace the brake pad.
F45498
19.
(a)
INSPECT REAR DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT PLATE
Inspect the rear disc brake pad support plate (No.1) and the rear disc brake pad support plate (No.2).
(1) Make sure that both have sufficient rebound, have no deformation, cracks or wear, and that all
rust and dirt are cleaned off.
If necessary, replace the rear disc brake pad support plate.
20. INSPECT DISC THICKNESS
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness: 10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Minimum thickness: 8.5 mm (0.335 in.)
If the disc thickness is less than the minimum, replace the disc.
F45504
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3144
32-32
BRAKE
21.
(a)
Matchmarks
-
REAR BRAKE
REMOVE REAR DISC
Put matchmarks on the rear disc and the axle hub.
F45499
(b) Release the parking brake, and remove the rear disc.
HINT:
If the disc cannot be removed easily, turn the shoe adjuster until
the wheel turns freely.
Contract
D28126
22. REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ADJUSTING HOLE PLUG
(a) Remove the parking brake shoe adjusting hole plug from the rear disc.
23. INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ADJUSTING HOLE PLUG
(a) Install the parking brake shoe adjusting hole plug to the rear disc.
24. INSTALL REAR DISC
(a) Aligning the matchmarks, install the rear disc.
HINT:
When replacing the rear disc with a new one, select the installation position where the rear disc has the minimum runout.
25.
(a)
26.
27.
(a)
28.
(a)
INSPECT DISC RUNOUT
Temporarily fasten the rear disc with hub nuts.
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the disc runout 10 mm
(0.39 in.) away from the outer edge of the rear disc.
Maximum disc runout: 0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
(c) If the runout exceeds the maximum value, change the
installation positions of the disc and axle so that the runout will become minimal. If the runout exceeds the maxiC83570
mum even when the installation positions are changed,
check the bearing play in the axial direction and the axle
hub runout (see page 30-3 ). If the bearing play and the
axle hub runout are normal and if the disc thickness is not
within the specified range, shave the disc. If the disc thickness is less than the minimum, replace the disc.
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG
Temporarily tighten the rear disc brake bleeder plug to the disc brake cylinder assy rear LH.
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG CAP
Install the rear disc brake bleeder plug cap to the rear disc brake bleeder plug.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3145
32-33
BRAKE
29.
(a)
(b)
-
REAR BRAKE
INSTALL PISTON SEAL
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to a new piston seal.
Install the piston seal to the disc brake cylinder assy rear LH.
30.
(a)
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE PISTON
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the rear disc
brake piston and a new cylinder boot.
(b) Install the cylinder boot to the rear disc brake piston.
(c) Install the piston to the disc brake cylinder assy rear LH.
NOTICE:
Do not install the piston forcibly in the disc brake cylinder.
Cylinder Boot
Piston
Lithium soap base glycol grease
F45750
31.
(a)
INSTALL CYLINDER BOOT
Install the cylinder boot to the disc brake cylinder assy
rear LH.
NOTICE:
Install the boot securely onto the grooves of the cylinder and the piston.
Do not damage the cylinder boot.
Piston
Cylinder Boot
Groove
Cylinder
G24324
Slide Pin No.2
32.
(a)
Cylinder Slide Bush
(b)
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE BUSH
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to a new rear disc
brake cylinder slide bush.
Install the rear disc brake cylinder slide bush to the rear
disc brake cylinder slide pin No.2.
Lithium soap base glycol grease
F45796
33.
(a)
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CYLINDER MOUNTING
LH
Install the rear disc brake cylinder mounting LH with the
2 bolts.
Torque: 78 N⋅m (800 kgf⋅cm, 58 ft⋅lbf)
G21636
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3146
32-34
BRAKE
Rear Disc Brake Cylinder Mounting
34.
(a)
(b)
-
REAR BRAKE
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE BUSH DUST BOOT
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the seal surface
of 2 new rear disc brake bush dust boots.
Install the 2 rear disc brake bush dust boots to the rear
disc brake cylinder mounting LH.
Bush Dust Boot
Lithium soap base glycol grease
35.
(a)
F45436
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT PLATE
Install the rear disc brake pad support plate (No.1) and the rear disc brake pad support plate (No.2)
to the rear disc brake cylinder mounting LH.
36.
(a)
Anti Squeal Shim
Anti Squeal Shim
Disc brake grease
F45500
INSTALL ANTI SQUEAL SHIM KIT REAR
Apply disc brake grease to the inside of the anti squeal
shims and install them and the pad wear indicators to
each of the 2 brake pads.
NOTICE:
When replacing worn pads, the anti squeal shims
must be replaced together with the pads.
Install the pad wear indicator and anti squeal shims
in the correct positions and directions.
37. INSTALL DISC BRAKE PAD KIT REAR (PAD ONLY)
(a) Install the 2 brake pads with anti squeal shims to the rear disc brake cylinder mounting LH.
NOTICE:
There should be no oil or grease on the friction surface of the pads and the disc.
38.
(a)
INSTALL DISC BRAKE CYLINDER ASSY REAR LH
Install the disc brake cylinder assy rear LH.
39.
(a)
INSTALL REAR DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE PIN
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the sliding part
and the seal surface of the 2 slide pins.
Install the rear disc brake cylinder slide pin.
Install the rear disc brake cylinder slide pin No.2 to the
bottom side of the rear disc brake cylinder mounting LH.
F45897
Cylinder Slide Pin
Cylinder Slide Pin No.2
Lithium soap base glycol grease
(b)
(c)
G24410
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3147
32-35
BRAKE
(d)
Slide Pin
-
REAR BRAKE
Fully tighten the rear disc brake cylinder slide pin and the
rear disc brake cylinder slide pin No.2.
Torque: 43 N⋅m (440 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
Slide Pin No.2
G21633
40.
(a)
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
46.
47.
CONNECT REAR LH FLEXIBLE HOSE
Connect the flexible hose with the union bolt and a new gasket.
Torque: 29 N⋅m (300 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
BLEED MASTER CYLINDER (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
SST 09023-00101
BLEED BRAKE LINE (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
BLEED BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3148
32-36
BRAKE
-
BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY
BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY
320WL-05
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
Hand-Held Tester
DLC3
1.
CONNECT HAND-HELD TESTER:
(a) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Start the engine and run at idle.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the hand-held tester.
HINT:
Please refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
G23361
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSPECT ACTUATOR MOTOR OPERATION
With the motor relay on, check the actuator motor operation noise.
Turn the motor relay off.
Depress the brake pedal and hold it for about 15 seconds. Check that the brake pedal cannot be depressed.
(d) With the motor relay on, check that the pedal does not pulsate.
NOTICE:
Do not keep a motor relay on for more than 5 seconds continuously. When operating it continuously,
set an interval of more than 20 seconds.
(e) Turn the motor relay off and release the brake pedal.
3.
INSPECT RIGHT FRONT WHEEL OPERATION
NOTICE:
Never turn on the solenoids in a manner different to those described below.
(a) With the brake pedal depressed, perform the following operations.
(b) Turn the SFRH and SFRR solenoids on simultaneously, and check that the pedal cannot be depressed.
NOTICE:
Do not keep a solenoid turned on for more than 10 seconds continuously. When operating it continuously, set an interval of more than 20 seconds.
(c) Turn the SFRH and SFRR solenoids off simultaneously, and check that the pedal can be depressed.
(d) Turn the motor relay on, and check that the pedal returns.
NOTICE:
Do not keep a motor relay turned on for more than 5 seconds continuously. When operating it continuously, set an interval of more than 20 seconds.
(e) Turn the motor relay off and release the brake pedal.
4.
INSPECT OTHER WHEEL OPERATION
(a) Using the same procedure, check the solenoids of the other wheels.
HINT:
Left front wheel: SFLH, SFLR
Right rear wheel: SRRH, SRRR
Left rear wheel: SRLH, SRLR
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3149
32-37
BRAKE
-
BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY
320WM-10
REPLACEMENT
1.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
2.
DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any painted surface.
3.
(a)
REMOVE BRAKE ACTUATOR WITH BRACKET
Using SST, disconnect the 6 brake tubes from the actuator with bracket.
SST 09023-00101
(b)
Use tags or make a memo to identify the places to reconnect.
(c)
(d)
Pull the lock lever upward.
Disconnect the actuator connector.
F46635
From M/C Rear
From M/C Front
To FL W/C
To RR W/C
F46636
(c)
To FR W/C
To RL W/C
F47079
(d)
F46637
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3150
32-38
BRAKE
-
BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY
(e) Remove the 2 bolts, the nut and the actuator with bracket.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the brake tubes and wire harness.
F46638
4.
(a)
5.
(a)
REMOVE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY
Remove the 2 nuts and the brake actuator assy from the brake actuator bracket.
INSTALL BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY
Install the brake actuator assy with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
6.
INSTALL BRAKE ACTUATOR WITH BRACKET
(a) Install the actuator with bracket and the 2 bolts and the
nut.
Torque: 19 N⋅m (194 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the brake tubes and wire harness.
(b) Connect the actuator connector.
F46638
(c)
From M/C Front
To FL W/C
To RR W/C
F46636
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
From M/C Rear
Using SST, connect each brake tube to correct positions
of the actuator with bracket, as shown in the illustration.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N⋅m (155 kgf⋅cm, 11 ft⋅lbf)
To FR W/C
To RL W/C
F47079
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
BLEED MASTER CYLINDER (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
SST 09023-00101
BLEED BRAKE LINE (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
BLEED BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR (SEE PAGE 32-4 )
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
PERFORM YAWRATE SENSOR ZERO POINT CALIBRATION (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3151
32-39
BRAKE
15.
-
BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSY
CHECK BRAKE ACTUATOR WITH HAND-HELD TESTER (SEE PAGE 32-36 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3152
33-2
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
330CI-04
ADJUSTMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
Strongly step on the parking brake pedal.
Release the parking brake.
Once more, slowly depress the parking brake pedal all the way, and count the number of clicks.
Parking brake pedal travel: 5 to 7 clicks at 300 N (31 kgf, 67.46 lbf)
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Lock Nut
(d)
(e)
Parking Brake
Adjusting Nut
(f)
G24942
(g)
(h)
(i)
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
Remove the instrument panel finish panel sub-assy lower.(see page 71-10 )
Remove the instrument PNL insert sub- assy LWR
LH.(see page 71-10 )
Depress the parking brake pedal 5 clicks to make room
for the procedure, and loosen the lock nut with fixing adjusting nut by wrench.
Release the parking brake pedal to the original position.
Turn the paking brake wire adjusting nut until the parking
brake pedal travel is correct.
Using a spanner or equivalent to hold the parking brake
adjusting nut, tighten the lock nut.
Torque: 6.0 N⋅m (61 kgf⋅cm, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Count the number of clicks after depressing and canceling the parking brake pedal 3 to 4 times.
Check whether the parking brake drags or not.
When operating the parking brake pedal, check that the
parking brake pedal indicator light is lit.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3163
33-1
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
330CH-04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely cause
of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
1. Parking brake pedal travel (Out of adjustment)
2. Parking brake wire (Sticking)
Brake drag
3. Parking brake shoe clearance (Out of adjustment)
4. Parking brake shoe lining (Cracked or distorted)
5. Tension or return spring (Damaged)
33-2
33-10
33-14
33-19
33-19
33-19
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3162
33-3
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
330CL-04
COMPONENTS
Parking Brake Pedal Assy
39 (400, 29)
Parking Brake Switch Assy
Clip
39 (400, 29)
Parking Brake Wire
Adjusting Nut No.1
39 (400, 29)
Parking Pedal Pad
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Lock Nut
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.1
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
F46471
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3164
33-4
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
8.5 (87, 75 in.⋅lbf)
FR Floor Footrest
Parking Brake Equalizer
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.1
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
F45547
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3165
33-5
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
330FC-01
OVERHAUL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
(a)
PRECAUTION (W/ SIDE AIRBAG) (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY LOWER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PNL INSERT SUB-ASSY LWR LH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER RH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER LH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
DISCONNECT TURN SIGNAL FLASHER ASSY
REMOVE FR FLOOR FOOTREST
Remove the front floor footrest from the floor.
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
Disconnect the connectors.
Remove the 2 nuts.
Separate the instrument panel junction block assy.
Release the parking brake pedal to the original position.
Remove the 2 bolts and nuts, and separate the parking
brake cable assy No.1 from the floor.
F46488
Nut
Nut
Bolt
F46472
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3166
33-6
PARKING BRAKE
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
-
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
Remove the parking brake cable assy No.1 from the parking brake equalizer.
Disconnect the parking brake switch connector.
Remove the 3 nuts and separate the instrument panel
junction block assy w/ bracket from the body.
Remove the 3 nuts and parking brake control pedal assy.
F46473
14.
15.
(a)
16.
(a)
17.
(a)
18.
(a)
19.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1 (SEE PAGE 33-10 )
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSY
Remove the screw and parking brake switch assy.
REMOVE PARKING PEDAL PAD
Remove the parking pedal pad.
INSTALL PARKING PEDAL PAD
Install the parking pedal pad.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSY
Install the parking brake switch assy with the screw.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1 (SEE PAGE 33-10 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3167
33-7
PARKING BRAKE
20.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
-
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
Install the parking brake control pedal assy with the 3
nuts.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the parking brake switch connector.
Connect the instrument panel junction block assy w/
bracket with the 3 nuts.
Attach the parking brake cable assy No.1 to the parking
brake equalizer and slide boot stopper of No.1 cable
should be inserted into groove of T-Metal fitting.
Install the parking brake cable assy No.1 with the 2 bolts
and 2 nuts.
Torque:
Bolt: 8.5 N⋅m (87 kgf⋅cm, 75 in.⋅lbf)
Nut: 6.0 N⋅m (61 kgf⋅cm, 53 in.⋅lbf)
F46473
Slide Boot
Nut
Nut
Bolt
F46472
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3168
33-8
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY
(f)
Install the instrument panel junction block assy with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 7.3 N⋅m (74 kgf⋅cm, 65 in.⋅lbf)
(g)
Connect the connectors.
F46488
21.
(a)
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
INSTALL FR FLOOR FOOTREST
Install the front floor footrest on the floor.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (W/ SIDE AIRBAG) (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3169
33-9
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
330CN-04
COMPONENTS
Parking Brake Pedal Assy
39 (400, 29)
Clip
39 (400, 29)
Parking Brake Wire
Adjusting Nut No.1
Lock Nut
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
39 (400, 29)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
8.5 (87, 75 in.⋅lbf)
FR Floor Footrest
Parking Brake Equalizer
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.1
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
F46475
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3170
33-10
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
330CO-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
PRECAUTION (W/ SIDE AIRBAG) (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY LOWER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PNL INSERT SUB-ASSY LWR LH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER RH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER LH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FR FLOOR FOOTREST (SEE PAGE 33-5 )
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY (SEE PAGE 33-5 )
13. REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the parking brake cable assy
No.1.
G24943
Parking Brake
Wire Adjusting
Nut No.1
(b)
(c)
Remove the clip from the parking brake pedal assy.
Remove the lock nut and parking brake wire adjusting nut
No.1.
14.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
Install the parking brake cable assy No.1 with the clip.
Temporarily install the parking brake wire adjusting nut
No.1 and lock nut.
Clip
Lock Nut
G24944
Parking Brake Wire
Adjusting Nut No.1
Clip
Lock Nut
G24944
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3171
33-1 1
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.1
(c) Bend the claw.
NOTICE:
Bend the claw fully.
G24943
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSY (SEE PAGE 33-5 )
INSTALL FR FLOOR FOOTREST (SEE PAGE 33-5 )
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (SEE PAGE 72-1 1, 72-19 )
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (W/ SIDE AIRBAG) (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3172
33-12
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
330CP-04
COMPONENTS
FF:
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.2
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.3
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
39 (400, 29)
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
39 (400, 29)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
8.5 (87, 75 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket No.1
Parking Brake Equalizer
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
G24937
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3173
33-13
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
4WD:
Rear Axle Hub & Bearing Assy RH
75 (765, 55)
Rear Axle Shaft Nut
294 (3,000, 217)
Parking Brake Hole RH
75 (765, 55)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Speed Sensor RR RH
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.2
Parking Brake Cable Assy No.3
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
39 (400, 29)
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
39 (400, 29)
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket No.1
8.5 (87, 75 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Equalizer
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Rear Axle Hub & Bearing Assy LH
Speed Sensor RR LH
Rear Axle Shaft Nut
294 (3,000, 217)
75 (765, 55)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Hole LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
75 (765, 55)
G24939
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3174
33-14
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
330CQ-04
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
For parking brake cable No.2, employ the same procedure to the No.3 side.
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and separate the rear disc brake caliper assy LH.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the rear brake caliper assy LH.
3.
REMOVE REAR DISC (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
4.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION SPRING (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
5.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
6.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.1 (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
7.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ADJUSTING SCREW SET (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
8.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.2 (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
9.
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
10. REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
11. REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
12.
(a)
FF:
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
Remove the 2 bolts and separate the parking brake cable
assy No.3 from the backing plate.
4WD:
F45450
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3175
33-15
PARKING BRAKE
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
Remove the 4 nuts and 2 bolts and separate the parking
brake cable assy No.3 from the body.
Separate the parking brake cable assy No.3 from the
equalizer and remove the parking brake cable assy No.3.
Remove the parking brake cable support bracket No.1
from the parking brake cable assy No.3.
Bolt A
Nut
Nut
Bolt B
Parking Brake Cable
Support Bracket No.1
Nut
G24918
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
Attach the parking brake cable support bracket No.1 to the parking brake cable assy No.3.
Connect the parking brake cable assy No.3 to the equalizer and slide boot stopper of No.1 cable should
be inserted into groove of T-Metal fitting.
Install the 4 nuts, 2 bolts and parking brake cable assy No.3 to the body.
Torque:
Bolt A: 8.5 N⋅m (87 kgf⋅cm, 75 in.⋅lbf)
Bolt B: 39 N⋅m (400 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
Nut: 6.0 N⋅m (61 kgf⋅cm, 53 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3176
33-16
PARKING BRAKE
(d)
FF:
-
PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSY NO.3
Connect the parking brake cable assy No.3 to the backing
plate with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
4WD:
F45450
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
(a)
27.
28.
(a)
29.
30.
31.
32.
APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.2 (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ADJUSTING SCREW SET (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.1 (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION SPRING (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
CHECK PARKING BRAKE INSTALLATION (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
INSPECT BEARING BACKLASH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
INSPECT AXLE HUB DEVIATION (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
INSTALL REAR DISC
Aligning the matchmarks, install the rear disc.
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE (SEE PAGE 33-19 )
CONNECT REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Install the rear disc brake caliper assy LH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 78 N⋅m (800 kgf⋅cm, 58 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3177
33-17
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
330CR-03
COMPONENTS
FF:
Parking Brake Shoe Strut LH
Rear Disc Brake Caliper Assy LH
Parking Brake Shoe
Strut Compression Spring
Parking Brake Shoe
Assy LH No.2
78 (800, 58)
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring Pin No.2
Parking Brake Shoe Hold Down
Spring Cup No.2
Parking Brake Shoe Return
Tension Spring No.1
Shim
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring
C-W asher
Parking Brake Shoe Lever
Parking Brake Shoe Hold Down
Spring Cup No.1
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring Pin No.1
Parking Brake
Shoe Assy LH No.1
Parking Brake Shoe
Adjusting Screw Set
Parking Brake Shoe
Return Tension Spring No.2
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring Cup No.2
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring
Parking Brake Shoe Hold Down
Spring Cup No.1
Rear Disc
Parking Brake Shoe
Adjusting Hole Plug
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
High Temperature grease
F47274
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3178
33-18
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
4WD:
Speed Sensor RR LH
Rear Disc Brake Caliper Assy LH
78 (800, 58)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Parking Brake Shoe
Strut Compression Spring
78 (800, 58)
Parking Brake Shoe Strut LH
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring Pin No.2
Parking Brake Shoe
Assy LH No.2
Parking Brake Shoe Return
Tension Spring No.1
C-W asher
Parking Brake Shoe Hold Down
Spring Cup No.2
Shim
Parking Brake Shoe Lever
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring
Parking Brake Shoe Hold Down
Spring Cup No.1
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring
Pin No.1
75 (765, 55)
Parking Brake Shoe
Assy LH No.1
Rear Axle Shaft Nut
294 (3,000, 217)
Parking Brake Shoe
ReturnTension Spring No.2
Parking Brake Shoe
Adjusting Screw Set
75 (765, 55)
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring Cup No.2
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
High Temperature grease
Parking Brake Shoe
Hold Down Spring
Rear Disc
Rear Axle
Hub & Bearing Assy LH
Parking Brake Shoe
Adjusting Hole Plug
F47275
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3179
33-19
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
330CS-04
OVERHAUL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
SEPARATE REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Remove the 2 bolts and separate the rear disc brake caliper assy LH.
1.
2.
(a)
HINT:
Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the disc brake caliper assy LH.
3.
REMOVE REAR DISC
(a) Release the parking brake, and remove the rear disc.
HINT:
If the disc cannot be removed easily, turn the shoe adjuster until
the wheel turns freely.
Contract
D28126
(b)
(c)
Machmarks
Place machmarks on the rear disc and the axle hub.
Remove the rear disc.
F41543
4.
(a)
INSPECT BRAKE DISC INSIDE DIAMETER
Using a brake drum gauge or equivalent tool, measure
the inside diameter of the rear disc.
Standard inside diameter: 190 mm (7.480 in.)
Maximum inside diameter: 191 mm (7.520 in.)
If the inside diameter exceeds the maximum, replace the brake
disc.
F06409
5.
(a)
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION
SPRING
Using needle-nose pliers, remove the 2 parking brake
shoe return tension springs No.1.
D28127
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3180
33-20
PARKING BRAKE
6.
(a)
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH
Remove the parking brake shoe strut LH and the parking brake shoe strut compression spring.
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
G25968
8.
Adjusting Screw Set
(a)
(b)
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.1
Remove the parking brake shoe hold down spring cup
No.1, parking brake shoe hold down spring and parking
brake shoe hold down spring cup No.2.
FF:
Remove the parking brake shoe hold down spring pin
No.1.
Disconnect the parking brake shoe return spring No.2
and remove the parking brake shoe assy LH No.1.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ADJUSTING
SCREW SET
Remove the parking brake shoe adjusting screw set.
Remove the parking brake shoe return tension spring
No.2.
Return tension Spring
F45549
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.2
Remove the parking brake shoe hold down spring cup
No.1, parking brake shoe hold down spring, parking
brake shoe hold down spring cup No.2 and parking brake
shoe hold down spring pin No.2.
Remove the parking brake shoe assy LH No.2.
G25969
(c)
Using needle-nose pliers, disconnect the parking brake
cable No.3 from the parking brake cable shoe lever.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage parking brake cable No.3.
R00310
10.
11.
12.
SEPARATE SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
REMOVE REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
SST 09930-00010
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3181
33-21
PARKING BRAKE
13.
(a)
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE HOLD DOWN
SPRING PIN (4WD DRIVE TYPE)
Remove the parking brake shoe hold down spring pin
No.1.
G24920
14.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE TYPE C WASHER
Using a screwdriver, remove the C-washer.
Remove the shim and parking brake shoe lever from
parking brake shoe assy LH No.2.
F41058
15.
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SHOE LINING
THICKNESS
(a) Using a ruler, measure the thickness of the shoe lining.
Standard thickness: 2.5 mm (0.098 in.)
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the lining thickness is less than or equal to the minimum, or
if there is severe or uneven wear, replace the brake shoe.
R00311
16.
INSPECT BRAKE DISC AND PARKING BRAKE SHOE
LINING FOR PROPER CONTACT
(a) Apply chalk to the inside surface of the disc, then grind
down the brake shoe lining to fit disc.
If the contact between the brake disc and the shoe lining is improper, repair it using a brake shoe grinder or replace the brake
shoe assembly.
BR0828
17.
(a)
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE TYPE C WASHER
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard clearance: Less than 0.35 mm (0.014 in.)
If the clearance is not within the specifications, replace the shim
with one of the correct size.
Shim Thickness
Shim Thickness
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
-
R00343
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3182
33-22
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
(b)
Using pliers, install the parking brake shoe lever LH and
the shim with a new C-washer.
18.
(a)
APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE
Apply high temperature grease to the shaded parts
shown in the illustration of the backing plate which make
contact with the shoe.
19.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE HOLD DOWN
SPRING PIN (4WD DRIVE TYPE)
Install the parking brake shoe hold down spring pin No.1.
C64144
High Temperature Grease
C97930
(a)
G24920
20.
21.
22.
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB & BEARING ASSY LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
INSTALL REAR AXLE SHAFT LH NUT (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR REAR LH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-60 )
23.
(a)
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.2
Using needle-nose pliers, connect the parking brake
cable No.3 to the parking brake cable shoe lever.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the parking brake cable No.3.
R00310
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3183
33-23
PARKING BRAKE
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
(b)
Install the parking brake shoe assy LH No.2 with the parking brake shoe hold down spring, parking brake shoe hold
down spring cup No.1, parking brake shoe hold down
spring cup No.2 and parking brake shoe hold down spring
pin No.2.
24.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ADJUSTING
SCREW SET
Apply high temperature grease to the parking brake shoe
adjusting bolt and piece.
G25969
(a)
Piece
Adjusting Bolt
High Temperature Grease
F41705
(b)
Adjusting
Screw
Set
Return
tension
Spring
(c)
Adjusting Screw Set
Attach the parking brake shoe return tension spring No.2
to parking brake shoe assy LH No.1 and parking brake
shoe assy LH No.2.
Attach the parking brake shoe adjusting screw set to the
parking brake shoe assy LH No.1 and parking brake shoe
assy LH No.2.
F45550
25.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE ASSY LH NO.1
FF:
Install the parking brake shoe hold down spring pin No.1.
Install the parking brake shoe assy LH No.1 with the parking brake shoe hold down spring, parking brake shoe hold
down spring cup No.2, parking brake shoe hold down
spring cup No.2.
G25968
26.
(a)
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT LH
Attach the parking brake shoe strut LH and the parking brake shoe strut compression spring to parking
brake shoe assy LH No.2 and parking brake shoe assy LH No.1.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3184
33-24
PARKING BRAKE
27.
(a)
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE RETURN TENSION
SPRING
Using needle-nose pliers, install the 2 return tension
springs No.1 as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
First install the front side spring then the rear side spring.
D28127
28. CHECK PARKING BRAKE INSTALLATION
(a) Check that each part is installed properly.
NOTICE:
There should be no oil or grease on the friction surface of
the shoe lining and disc.
RH
Front
C88601
29.
30.
31.
(a)
LH
Front
F45453
INSPECT BEARING BACKLASH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
INSPECT AXLE HUB DEVIATION (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-3 )
INSTALL REAR DISC
Aligning the matchmarks, install the rear disc.
32.
(a)
(b)
Expand
(c)
(d)
(e)
Contract
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE
Temporarily install the hub nuts.
Remove the hole plug, turn the adjuster and expand the
shoes until the disc locks.
Contract the shoe adjuster until the disc rotates smoothly.
Standard : Return 8 notches
Check that the shoe has no brake drag.
Install the hole plug.
F45452
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3185
33-25
PARKING BRAKE
33.
(a)
34.
35.
36.
37.
-
PARKING BRAKE ASSY
CONNECT REAR DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSY LH
Install the rear disc brake caliper assy LH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 78 N⋅m (800 kgf⋅cm, 58 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (SEE PAGE 33-2 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3186
40-32
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
SPEED SENSOR (U151E/U151F)
SPEED SENSOR (U151E/U151F)
40060-09
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
REMOVE BATTERY
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSY
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE NO.1
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SPEED SENSOR (NT SENSOR)
Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
Remove the bolt and speed sensor.
5.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SPEED SENSOR (NC SENSOR)
Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
Remove the bolt and speed sensor.
6.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR (NC SENSOR)
Coat the O-ring with ATF.
Install the speed sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 11 N⋅m (115 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf)
C90569
C90570
HINT:
Make sure of the sensor manufacturer’s name.
(c) Connect the speed sensor connector.
C90570
7.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR (NT SENSOR)
Coat the O-ring with ATF.
Install the speed sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 11 N⋅m (115 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Make sure of the sensor manufacturer’s name.
(c) Connect the speed sensor connector.
C90569
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3218
40-33
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
8.
9.
10.
11.
-
SPEED SENSOR (U151E/U151F)
INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE NO.1
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSY
INSTALL BATTERY
PERFORM INITIALIZATION(SEE PAGE 01-4 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3219
40-37
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TRANSMISSION WIRE (U151E/U151F)
TRANSMISSION WIRE (U151E/U151F)
400FS-04
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
Remove the drain plug and gasket, and drain ATF.
Install a new gasket and the drain plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
3.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OIL PAN
SUB-ASSY
(a) Remove the 18 bolts, oil pan and gasket.
NOTICE:
Some fluid will remain in the oil pan. Remove all of the oil
pan bolts, and carefully remove the oil pan assembly.
C91925
(b)
Remove the 2 magnets from the oil pan.
(c)
Examine the particles in the oil pan.
(1) Remove the magnets and use them to collect any
steel chips. Look at the chips and particles in the
pan and on the magnet carefully to see the type of
wear which might be found in the transaxle.
Steel (magnetic): bearing, gear and plate wear
Brass (non-magnetic): bearing wear
4.
(a)
(b)
DISCONNECT TRANSMISSION WIRE
Disconnect the 7 shift solenoid valve connectors.
Remove the bolt and lock plate, and disconnect the ATF
temperature sensor.
D30865
AT0103
C91927
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3223
40-38
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TRANSMISSION WIRE (U151E/U151F)
5.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE TRANSMISSION WIRE
Disconnect the transmission wire connectors.
Remove the bolt and transmission wire.
6.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION WIRE
Coat an O-ring of the transmission wire connector with
ATF.
(b)
Install the transmission wire and bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
7.
(a)
(b)
CONNECT TRANSMISSION WIRE
Coat an O-ring of the ATF temperature sensor with ATF.
Install the ATF temperature sensor with the lock plate and
bolt.
Torque: 6.6 N⋅m (67 kgf⋅cm, 58 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the 7 shift solenoid valve connectors.
D30866
D30867
D30866
(c)
C91927
8.
Magnet
(a)
(b)
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OIL PAN
SUB-ASSY
Install the 2 magnets in the oil pan.
Apply the seal packing or equivalent to the 18 bolts.
Seal packing:
THREE BOND 1344 or equivalent
D30865
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3224
40-39
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TRANSMISSION WIRE (U151E/U151F)
(c)
Install a new gasket, oil pan and 18 bolts to the transaxle
case.
Torque: 7.8 N⋅m (80 kgf⋅cm, 69 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Apply the seal packing or equivalent to the bolts and tighten them within 10 minutes of application.
C91925
9.
10.
11.
12.
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
RESET MEMORY (SEE PAGE 05-1005 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3225
40-44
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY (U151E/U151F)
TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY (U151E/U151F)
400FT-04
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
Remove the drain plug and gasket, and drain ATF.
Install a new gasket and the drain plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
3.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OIL PAN
SUB-ASSY
(a) Remove the 18 bolts, oil pan and gasket.
NOTICE:
Some fluid will remain in the oil pan. Remove all of the oil
pan bolts, and carefully remove the oil pan assembly.
C91925
(b)
Remove the 2 magnets from the oil pan.
(c)
Examine the particles in the oil pan.
(1) Remove the magnets and use them to collect any
steel chips. Look at the chips and particles in the
pan and on the magnet carefully to see the type of
wear which might be found in the transaxle.
Steel (magnetic): bearing, gear and plate wear
Brass (non-magnetic): bearing wear
4.
(a)
(b)
DISCONNECT TRANSMISSION WIRE
Disconnect the 7 shift solenoid valve connectors.
Remove the bolt and lock plate, and disconnect the ATF
temperature sensor.
D30865
AT0103
C91927
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3230
40-45
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY (U151E/U151F)
5.
REMOVE VALVE BODY OIL STRAINER ASSY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and oil strainer.
NOTICE:
Be careful that some fluid will come out of the oil strainer.
C91931
(b)
Remove the O-ring from the oil strainer.
C91932
6.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY
Support the valve body assy and remove the 17 bolts and
the valve body assy.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the check valve body, spring and accumulator piston.
C91933
(b)
Remove the check ball body and spring.
F46566
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3231
40-46
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY (U151E/U151F)
(c)
Remove the 5 bolts, 3 lock plates and 7 shift solenoid
valves.
7.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY
Install the spring and check ball body.
(b)
Install the 7 shift solenoid valves and 3 lock plates with
the 5 bolts.
Torque:
Bolts A, B: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft.⋅lbf)
Bolts C, D: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in. lbf)
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 16 mm (0.63 in.)
Bolt B: 57 mm (2.2 in.)
Bolt C: 20 mm (0.9 in.)
Bolt D: 12 mm (0.47 in.)
D30644
F46566
B
A
B
C
D
D30644
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3232
40-47
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY (U151E/U151F)
(c)
C
A
B
B
B
C
B
A
B
C
C
C
C91933
Align the groove of the manual valve with the pin of the
lever.
(d) Install the 17 bolts.
Torque: 11 N⋅m (110 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Push the valve body against the accumulator piston
spring and the check ball body to install it.
First, temporarily tighten those bolts marked by in
the illustration because they are positioning bolts.
Bolt length:
Bolts A: 25 mm (0.984 in.)
Bolts B: 57 mm (2.244 in.)
Bolts C: 41 mm (1.614 in.)
8.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL VALVE BODY OIL STRAINER ASSY
Coat a new O-ring with ATF.
Install the O-ring to the oil strainer.
(c)
Install the oil strainer with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 11 N⋅m (110 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf)
9.
(a)
(b)
CONNECT TRANSMISSION WIRE
Coat an O-ring with ATF.
Install the ATF temperature sensor with the lock plate and
bolt.
Torque: 6.6 N⋅m (67 kgf⋅cm, 58 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the 7 shift solenoid valve connectors.
C91932
C91931
(c)
C91927
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3233
40-48
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
10.
Magnet
(a)
(b)
-
TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY (U151E/U151F)
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OIL PAN
SUB-ASSY
Install the 2 magnets to the oil pan.
Apply the seal packing or equivalent to the 18 bolts.
Seal packing:
THREE BOND 1344 or equivalent
D30865
(c)
Install a new gasket, the oil pan and 18 bolts to the transaxle case.
Torque: 7.8 N⋅m (80 kgf⋅cm, 69 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Apply seal packing or equivalent to the bolts and tighten
them within 10 minutes of application.
C91925
11.
12.
13.
14.
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
RESET MEMORY (SEE PAGE 05-1005 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3234
40-55
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (U151E)
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (U151E)
40066-10
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
(a)
(b)
4.
5.
REMOVE FRONT WHEELS
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
Remove the drain plug, gasket and drain ATF.
Install a new gasket and the drain plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST 09520-01010, 09520-24010 (09520-32040)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (2WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST
6.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSAXLE HOUSING OIL SEAL
Using SST, pull out the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
7.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL
Using SST, pull out the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
D25831
SST
(a)
D25832
8.
(a)
SST
(b)
INSTALL TRANSAXLE HOUSING OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09316-6001 1 (09316-00011)
Oil seal drive in depth:
0 0.5 mm (0 0.020 in.)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
D25833
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3241
40-56
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
9.
(a)
(b)
-
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (U151E)
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09223-15020, 09950-70010 (09951-07150)
Oil seal drive in depth:
0 0.5 mm (0 0.020 in.)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
D25834
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (2WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEELS
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3242
40-71
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (ATM)
40128-02
ADJUSTMENT
1.
(a)
With the brake pedal depressed,
shift while holding the shift lever
knob button in. (The ignition
switch must be in ON position.)
Shift while holding the shift
lever knob button in.
(b)
INSPECT SHIFT LEVER POSITION
When shifting the shift lever to each position, make sure
that it moves smoothly, can be moderately operated and
the position indicator displays correctly.
Positions which can be operated without pressing
the shift lever knob button
R → N → D, L → 2 → 3 → D → N
Positions which can be operated only while pressing
the shift lever knob button
D → 3 → 2 → L, N → R → P
Positions which can be operated only while pressing
the shift lever knob button, ignition switch ON and
brake pedal depressed
P→R
When starting the engine, make sure that the vehicle
moves forward when shifting from N to D position, and
moves backward when shifting to R position.
Shift normally
F46552
2.
(a)
ADJUST SHIFT LEVER POSITION
Loosen the nut on the control shaft lever.
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Push the control shaft fully downward.
Return the control shaft lever 2 notches to N position.
Set the shift lever to N position.
While holding the shift lever lightly toward the R position
side, tighten the shift lever nut.
Torque: 14.7 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 10 ft·lbf)
Start the engine and make sure that the vehicle moves
forward when shifting the lever from the N to D position
and moves backward when shifting it to the R position.
D25118
(f)
D25119
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3257
40-61
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (ATM)
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (ATM)
4016Z-01
COMPONENTS
Shift Lever Knob
Shift Lever Knob Cover No.1
Spring
Shift Lever Knob Cover
Transmission Control Switch
Shift Lock Release Cover
Shift Lever Knob Button
Control Position Indicator Plate
Shift Lock Release Button
Position Indicator Housing Upper
Spring
Position Indicator Slide Cover
Position Indicator Slide Cover No.2
Position Indicator Housing Lower
Position Indicator Light Guide
Transmission Shift Main Switch
Indicator Lamp Cap
Shift Lever Knob Sleeve
Indicator Lamp Bulb
Pattern Select
Switch Assy No.1
Indicator Lamp Wire
Sub-assy
Apply MP grease
F46553
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3247
40-62
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (ATM)
40170-02
OVERHAUL
HINT:
COMPONENTS:
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (See page 40-61 )
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE71-10 )
2.
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER RH (SEE PAGE71-10 )
3.
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER LH (SEE PAGE71-10 )
4.
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSY (SEE PAGE71-10 )
5.
(a)
DISCONNECT TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
ASSY
Disconnect the floor shift transmission control cable assy
end from the floor shift assy.
Floor Shift Transmission Control Cable
D25449
Front
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FLOOR SHIFT ASSY
Disconnect the 3 connectors.
Remove the 4 nuts and dismount the floor shift assy from
the vehicle.
7.
(a)
REMOVE SHIFT LEVER KNOB SUB-ASSY
Releasing the lock by pressing the click, disconnect the
indicator lamp wire connector from the shift lever plate.
(b)
(c)
Using a screwdriver, release the stopper of the connector.
Using a small screwdriver, disengage the locking lug of
the terminals 2 and 6, and pull the terminals out from the
rear.
Disconnect the 2 wire harnesses of the transmission control switch from the clamp.
D31757
Front
D31758
Stopper
(d)
G30611
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3248
40-63
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
(e)
(f)
-
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (ATM)
Lower the shift lever knob cover.
Remove the 2 screws and shift lever knob from the shift
lever.
D25427
8.
(a)
REMOVE FLOOR SHIFT SHIFT LEVER KNOB COVER
Remove the shift lever knob cover from the shift lever.
9.
(a)
REMOVE SHIFT LEVER KNOB BUTTON
Using a screwdriver, release the claw and remove the
shift lever knob button and spring from the shift lever
knob.
10.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH
Remove the screw from the shift lever knob, detach the
transmission control switch together with the shift lever
knob cover No.1.
(b)
Using a screwdriver, release the 2 claws and remove the
transmission control switch from the shift lever knob cover
No.1.
Shift Lever Knob Button
D25426
D25428
D25431
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3249
40-64
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
Stopper
-
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (ATM)
11.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE INDICATOR LAMP WIRE SUB-ASSY
Using a screwdriver, release the stopper of the connector.
Using a small screwdriver, disengage the locking lug of
the terminals 3 and 7, and pull the terminals out from the
rear.
(c)
Remove the indicator lamp wire from the position indicator housing lower.
Remove the indicator lamp cap and indicator lamp bulb
from the indicator lamp wire.
D31759
(d)
F46549
12.
(a)
REMOVE SHIFT LOCK RELEASE BUTTON COVER
Using a small screwdriver, remove the shift lock release
cover from the control position indicator plate.
13.
(a)
REMOVE CONTROL POSITION INDICATOR PLATE
Using a screwdriver, release the 4 claws and remove the
control position indicator plate from the position indicator
housing lower.
14.
(a)
REMOVE POSITION INDICATOR HOUSING LOWER
Remove the 4 screws, detach the position indicator housing lower from the shift lever plate.
F46550
D25429
G30569
D31850
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3250
40-65
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (ATM)
15.
(a)
REMOVE SHIFT LOCK RELEASE BUTTON
While pressing the 2 claws, remove the shift lock release
button and spring from the position indicator housing lower.
16.
(a)
REMOVE PATTERN SELECT SWITCH ASSY NO.1
Using a screwdriver, release the 4 claws and remove the
pattern select switch assy No.1 from the position indicator
housing lower.
17.
(a)
REMOVE POSITION INDICATOR HOUSING UPPER
Using a screwdriver,release the 4 claws and remove the
position indicator housing upper from the position indicator housing loweh.
18.
(a)
REMOVE POSITION INDICATOR SLIDE COVER
Remove the position indicator slide cover from the position indicator housing lower.
Remove the position indicator light guide from the position indicator lower.
D25433
C83287
D31851
(b)
D31852
19.
(a)
REMOVE POSITION INDICATOR SLIDE COVER
Remove the position indicator slide cover No.2 from the
position indicator slide cover.
D31853
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3251
40-66
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (ATM)
20.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSMISSION SHIFT MAIN SWITCH
Remove the screw and transmission shift main switch
from the position indicator housing lower.
21.
(a)
REMOVE SHIFT LEVER KNOB SLEEVE
Remove the shift lever knob sleeve from the shift lever.
22.
(a)
INSTALL SHIFT LEVER KNOB SLEEVE
Apply MP grease to the shown part of the shift lever knob
sleeve and install it to the shift lever.
23.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION SHIFT MAIN SWITCH
Install the transmission shift main switch to the position indicator housing lower with the screw.
24.
(a)
INSTALL POSITION INDICATOR SLIDE COVER
Install the position indicator slide cover No.2 to the position indicator slide cover.
D31854
Shift Lever
Knob Sleeve
C83299
Shift Lever
Knob Sleeve
C83299
D31854
D31853
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3252
40-67
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
25.
(a)
(b)
-
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (ATM)
INSTALL POSITION INDICATOR SLIDE COVER
Install the position indicator slide cover to the position indicator housing lower.
Install the position indicator light guide to the position indicator housing lower.
D31852
26.
(a)
INSTALL POSITION INDICATOR HOUSING UPPER
Install the position indicator housing upper to the position
indicator housing lower.
27.
(a)
INSTALL PATTERN SELECT SWITCH ASSY NO.1
Install the pattern select switch assy No. 1 to the position
indicator housing lower.
D31851
HINT:
Fit the claws securely.
C83287
28.
(a)
INSTALL SHIFT LOCK RELEASE BUTTON
Install the shift lock release button and greased spring to
the position indicator housing lower.
HINT:
Fit the claws securely.
D25433
29.
(a)
INSTALL POSITION INDICATOR HOUSING LOWER
Install the position indicator housing lower to the shift lever plate with 4 screws.
D31850
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3253
40-68
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
30.
(a)
-
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (ATM)
INSTALL CONTROL POSITION INDICATOR PLATE
Install the control position indicator plate to the position indicator housing lower.
HINT:
Fit the claws securely.
D25429
G30569
31.
(a)
INSTALL SHIFT LOCK RELEASE BUTTON COVER
Install the shift lock release cover to the control position
indicator plate.
32.
(a)
INSTALL INDICATOR LAMP WIRE SUB-ASSY
Install the indicator lamp bulb and indicator lamp cap to
the indicator lamp wire.
Install the indicator lamp wire to the position indicator
housing lower.
F46550
(b)
F46549
33.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH
Install the transmission control switch to the shift lever
knob cover No.1.
HINT:
Fit the claws securely.
D25431
(b)
Install the shift lever knob cover No.1 to the shift lever
knob with a screw.
D25428
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3254
40-69
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
34.
(a)
-
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (ATM)
INSTALL SHIFT LEVER KNOB BUTTON
Apply MP grease to the shift lever knob button and spring
and install them to the shift lever knob.
D25426
35.
(a)
INSTALL SHIFT LEVER KNOB COVER NO.1
Install the shift lever knob cover to the shift lever.
36.
(a)
INSTALL SHIFT LEVER KNOB SUB-ASSY
Install the wire harness of the transmission control switch
as shown in the illustration.
(b)
(c)
(d)
Install the shift lever knob to the shift lever with 2 screws.
Install the shift lever knob cover to shift lever knob.
Install the 2 wire harnesses of the transmission control
switch.
(e)
Install the indicator lamp wire harness and connector as
shown in the illustration.
G30617
D25427
D31758
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3255
40-70
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
37.
(a)
B
A
-
SHIFT LEVER ASSY (ATM)
INSTALL FLOOR SHIFT ASSY
Install the floor shift assy to the vehicle with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 12 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Tighten them in the order, A, B, C and D.
(b) Connect the 3 connectors.
D
C
D31757
38.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY
Connect the floor shift transmission control cable end to
the floor shift assy.
HINT:
Install it with the uneven surface facing up.
Floor Shift Transmission Control Cable
D25449
39.
40.
INSPECT SHIFT LEVER POSITION (SEE PAGE40-71 )
ADJUST SHIFT LEVER POSITION (SEE PAGE40-71 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3256
40-57
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (U151F)
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (U151F)
4012E-04
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
When replacing the front differential oil seal (LH) or (RH), perform step 1 to 11 or 12 to 23 respectively.
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
3.
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
(a) Remove the drain plug, gasket and drain ATF.
(b) Install a new gasket and the drain plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
4.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST 09520-01010, 09520-24010 (09520-32040)
5.
SST
(a)
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL
Using SST, pull out the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
D25832
6.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09223-15020, 09950-70010 (09951-07200)
Oil seal drive in depth:
0 0.5 mm (0 0.020 in.)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
D25834
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST 09520-01010, 09520-24010 (09520-32040)
REMOVE TRANSFER STIFFENER PLATE RH (SEE PAGE 40-20 )
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION W/TRANSFER (SEE PAGE 40-20 )
REMOVE TRANSFER ASSY (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3243
40-58
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (U151F)
17.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSAXLE HOUSING OIL SEAL
Using a screwdriver with vinyl tape wrapped around its tip,
remove the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the housing.
D30693
A
18.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL TRANSAXLE HOUSING OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09649-17010, 09950-70010 (09951-07200)
Oil seal drive in depth:
6.0 0.5 mm (0.236 0.020 in.)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
D30913
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
INSTALL TRANSFER ASSY (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION W/TRANSFER (SEE PAGE 40-20 )
INSTALL TRANSFER STIFFENER PLATE RH (SEE PAGE 40-20 )
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
RESET MEMORY (SEE PAGE 05-1005 )
PERFORM INITIALIZATION (SEE PAGE 01-4 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3244
40-50
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
OIL W/HOSE COOLER ASSY (U151E/U151F)
OIL W/HOSE COOLER ASSY (U151E/U151F)
4012F-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER (SEE PAGE 76-2 )
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
Remove the drain plug and gasket, and drain ATF.
Install a new gasket and the drain plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE OIL COOLER ASSY
Disconnect the 2 oil cooler hoses.
Remove the bolt, nut and oil cooler assy.
D25421
4.
INSTALL OIL COOLER ASSY
(a) Install the oil cooler assy, bolt A and nut B.
HINT:
After temporarily tightening the bolt A, fully tighten in order of
the nut B, bolt A.
Torque: 7.0 N⋅m (71 kgf⋅cm, 62 in.⋅lbf)
(b) Connect the 2 oil cooler hoses.
B
A
D25421
5.
6.
7.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER COVER (SEE PAGE 76-2 )
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3236
40-1
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (ATM)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (ATM)
4005T-09
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
The automatic transaxle is composed of highly precision-finished parts, necessitating careful
inspection before reassembly because even a small nick could cause fluid leakage or affect
the performance. The instructions here are organized so that you work on only one component
group at a time. This will help avoid confusion from similar-looking parts of different sub-assemblies being on your workbench at the same time. The component groups are inspected and
repaired from the converter housing side. As much as possible, complete the inspection, repair
and reassembly before proceeding to the next component group. If a defect is found in a certain
component group during reassembly, inspect and repair this group immediately. If a component group cannot be assembled because parts are being ordered, be sure to keep all parts of
the group in a separate container while proceeding with disassembly, inspection, repair and
reassembly of other component groups.
Recommended ATF: T-IV
All disassembled parts should be washed clean and any fluid passages and holes should be
blown through with compressed air.
Dry all parts with compressed air, never use shop rags.
When using compressed air, always aim away from yourself to prevent accidentally spraying
ATF or kerosene on your face.
The recommended automatic transaxle fluid or kerosene should be used for cleaning.
After cleaning, the parts should be arranged in the correct order for efficient inspection, repairs,
and reassembly.
When disassembling a valve body, be sure to match each valve together with the corresponding spring.
New discs for the brakes and clutches that are to be used for replacement must be soaked in
ATF for at least 15 minutes before reassembly.
All oil seal rings, clutch discs, clutch plates, rotating parts, and sliding surfaces should be
coated with ATF prior to reassembly.
All gaskets and rubber O-rings should be replaced.
Do not apply adhesive cements to gaskets and similar parts.
Make sure that the ends of a snap ring are not aligned with one of the cutouts and are installed
in the groove correctly.
If a worn bushing is to be replaced, the sub-assembly containing the bushing must also be replaced.
Check thrust bearings and races for wear or damage. Replace if necessary.
Use petroleum jelly to keep parts in place.
When working with FIPG material, you must observe the following.
Using a razor blade and a gasket scraper, remove all the old packing (FIPG) material from the
gasket surface.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the loose material.
Clean both sealing surfaces with a non-residue solvent.
Parts must be reassembled within 10 minutes of application. Otherwise, the packing (FIPG) material must be removed and reapplied.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3187
40-2
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (ATM)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (ATM)
4005R-09
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK FLUID LEVEL
HINT:
Drive the vehicle so that the engine and transaxle are at normal
operating temperature.
Fluid temperature: 70 - 80°C (158 - 176°F)
(1)
OK if hot
Add if hot
D25120
Park the vehicle on a level surface and set the parking brake.
(2) With the engine idling and the brake pedal depressed, shift the shift lever into all positions from P
to L position and return to P position.
(3) Pull out the dipstick and wipe it clean.
(4) Push it back fully into the pipe.
(5) Pull it out and check that the fluid level is in the HOT
position.
If there are leaks, it is necessary to repair or replace O-rings,
FIPGs, oil seals, plugs or other parts.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3188
40-31
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
SPEED SENSOR (U241E/U140F)
SPEED SENSOR (U241E/U140F)
400TX-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
REMOVE BATTERY
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSY
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE NO.1
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SPEED SENSOR (NT SENSOR)
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the bolt and speed sensor.
5.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SPEED SENSOR (NC SENSOR)
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the bolt and speed sensor.
6.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR (NC SENSOR)
Coat O-ring with ATF.
Install the speed sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 11.3 N⋅m (115 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf)
D25412
D25413
HINT:
Make sure of the manufacturer’s name.
(c) Connect the connector.
D25413
7.
(a)
(b)
D25412
INSTALL SPEED SENSOR (NT SENSOR)
Coat O-ring with ATF.
Install the speed sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 11.3 N⋅m (115 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Make sure of the manufacturer’s name.
(c) Connect the connector.
8.
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSY
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (51 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3217
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH AND DRIVE
PLATE (ATM)
40-29
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH AND DRIVE PLATE (ATM)
40063-11
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
SST
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY
Inspect the one-way clutch.
(1) Install SST into the inner race of the one- way
clutch.
SST 09350-32014 (09351-32010)
(2) Install SST so that it fits in the notch of the converter
hub and outer race of the one-way clutch.
SST 09350-32014 (09351-32020)
AT0953
(3)
Hold
Lock
Turn
Free
With the torque converter clutch setting up on its
side, check that the one-way clutch locks when it is
turned counterclockwise, and rotates smoothly
clockwise.
If necessary, clean the converter and retest the one- way
clutch.
Replace the converter if the one-way clutch still fails the test.
AT3306
(b)
Sample showing minimum amount of
powders in ATF
Actual Size
D25367
Determine the condition of the torque converter clutch
assy.
(1) If the inspection result of the torque converter clutch
assy meets the following item, replace the torque
converter clutch.
Malfunction item:
Any metallic sound is heard from the torque converter clutch during stall test or when the shift lever is in
neutral position.
One-way clutch is free or locked in both directions.
Fine powders exceeding the sample limit is identified
in ATF. (See the sample.)
HINT:
The sample shows the auto fluid of approx. 0.25 liters (0.26 US
qts, 0.22 Imp. qts) that is taken out from the removed torque
converter clutch
(c) Replace the ATF in the torque converter clutch.
(1) If the ATF is discolored and/or has a foul odor, completely stir the ATF in the torque converter clutch
and drain it with the face for installation facing up.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3215
40-30
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
(d)
-
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH AND DRIVE
PLATE (ATM)
Clean and check the oil cooler and oil pipe line.
(1) If the torque converter clutch is inspected or the ATF
is exchanged, clean the oil cooler and oil pipe line.
HINT:
C11090
(e)
OK
NG
The Bottom is
Damaged
Spray compressed air of 196 kPa (2 kgf/cm2, 28 psi) from
the inlet hose.
If plenty of fine powders are identified in the ATF, add new
ATF using a bucket pump and clean it again.
(2) If the ATF is cloudy, inspect the oil cooler (radiator).
Prevent deformation of the torque converter clutch and
damage to the oil pump gear.
(1) When any marks due to interference are found on
the end of the bolt for the torque converter clutch
and on the bottom of the bolt hole, replace the bolt
and the torque converter clutch.
(2) All of the bolts shall have the same length.
(3) No missing spring washer.
D25368
2.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT DRIVE PLATE & RING GEAR SUB-ASSY
Set up a dial indicator and measure the drive plate runout.
Check the damage of the ring gear.
Maximum runout: 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
If the runout is not within the specification or ring gear is damaged, replace the drive plate.
C81014
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3216
40-34
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TRANSMISSION WIRE (U241E/U140F)
TRANSMISSION WIRE (U241E/U140F)
4005V-06
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
Remove the drain plug, gasket and drain ATF.
Install a new gasket and drain plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
3.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OIL PAN
SUB-ASSY
(a) Remove the 18 bolts, oil pan and gasket.
NOTICE:
Some fluid will remain in the oil pan. Remove all pan bolts,
and carefully remove the oil pan assembly. Discard the
gasket.
(b) Remove the 2 magnets from the oil pan.
C83111
(c)
Examine particles in pan.
(1) Remove the magnets and use them to collect any
steel chips. Look carefully at the chips and particles
in the pan and the magnet to anticipate what type
of wear you will find in the transaxle.
Steel (magnetic): bearing, gear and plate wear
Brass (non-magnetic): bearing wear
4.
(a)
(b)
SEPARATE TRANSMISSION WIRE
Disconnect the 5 connectors.
Remove the bolt and lock plate, and remove the ATF temperature sensor.
5.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE TRANSMISSION WIRE
Disconnect the transmission wire connector.
Remove the bolt and transmission wire.
AT0103
D25591
C50009
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3220
40-35
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
6.
(a)
(b)
-
TRANSMISSION WIRE (U241E/U140F)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION WIRE
Coat a O-ring of the transmission wire connector with
ATF.
Install the transmission wire.
D03636
(c)
Install the bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
7.
(a)
(b)
CONNECT TRANSMISSION WIRE
Coat a O-ring of the ATF temperature sensor with ATF.
Install the ATF temperature sensor with the lock plate and
bolt.
Torque: 6.6 N⋅m (67 kgf⋅cm, 58 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the 5 shift solenoid valve connectors.
C50009
(c)
D25591
8.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OIL PAN
SUB-ASSY
Install the 2 magnets in the oil pan.
Apply seal packing or equivalent to 18 bolts.
Seal packing:
THREE BOND 2430 or equivalent
D25674
(c)
Install a new gasket, oil pan and 18 bolts to the transaxle
case.
Torque: 7.6 N⋅m (77 kgf⋅cm, 67 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Because the bolts should be seal bolts, apply seal packing
to bolts and tighten them within 10 minutes after application.
C83111
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3221
40-36
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
9.
10.
-
TRANSMISSION WIRE (U241E/U140F)
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID(SEE PAGE 40-2 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3222
40-40
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY (U241E/U140F)
TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY (U241E/U140F)
40064-06
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
Remove the drain plug, gasket and drain ATF.
Install a new gasket and drain plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
3.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OIL PAN
SUB-ASSY
(a) Remove the 18 bolts, oil pan and gasket.
NOTICE:
Some fluid will remain in the oil pan. Remove all pan bolts,
and carefully remove the oil pan assembly. Discard the
gasket.
(b) Remove the 2 magnets from the oil pan.
C83111
(c)
Examine particles in pan.
(1) Remove the magnets and use them to collect any
steel chips. Look carefully at the chips and particles
in the pan and the magnet to anticipate what type
of wear you will find in the transaxle.
Steel (magnetic): bearing, gear and plate wear
Brass (non-magnetic): bearing wear
4.
(a)
(b)
SEPARATE TRANSMISSION WIRE
Disconnect the 5 connectors.
Remove the bolt and lock plate, and remove the ATF temperature sensor.
AT0103
D25591
5.
REMOVE VALVE BODY OIL STRAINER ASSY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and oil strainer.
NOTICE:
Be careful as some fluid will come out with the oil strainer.
D09179
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3226
40-41
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
(b)
-
TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY (U241E/U140F)
Remove the O-ring from the oil strainer.
C69150
6.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY
Support the valve body assy and remove the 17 bolts and
the valve body assy.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the check valve body, spring and accumulator piston.
D03553
(b)
Remove the check ball body and spring.
(c)
Remove the 5 bolts and 5 shift solenoid valves.
7.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY
Install the 5 shift solenoid valves with the 5 bolts.
Torque:
6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.⋅lbf) for Bolt A
11 N·m (112 kgf·cm, 8 ft ·lbf) for Bolt B
Bolt length:
12 mm (0.47 in.) for Bolt A
45 mm (1.77 in.) for Bolt B
C50017
A
B
B
B
A
D02938
A
A
B
B
B
D02938
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3227
40-42
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
(b)
-
TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY (U241E/U140F)
Install the spring and check ball body.
C50017
(c)
(d)
A
C
B
A
C
B
A
C
B
D03553
Align the groove of the manual valve with the pin of lever.
Install the 17 bolts.
Torque: 11 N⋅m (110 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Push the valve body against the accumulator piston
spring and the check ball body to install it.
Tighten those bolts marked by in the illustration
first temporarily because they are positioning bolts.
Bolt length:
25 mm (0.984 in.) for Bolt A
41 mm (1.614 in.) for Bolt B
45 mm (1.771 in.) for Bolt C
8.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL VALVE BODY OIL STRAINER ASSY
Coat a new O-ring with ATF.
Install the O-ring to the oil strainer.
(c)
Install the oil strainer with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 11 N⋅m (110 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf)
C69150
D09179
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3228
40-43
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
TRANSMISSION VALVE BODY ASSY (U241E/U140F)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION WIRE
Coat a O-ring with ATF.
Install the ATF temperature sensor with the lock plate and
bolt.
Torque: 6.6 N⋅m (67 kgf⋅cm, 58 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the 5 shift solenoid valve connectors.
D25591
10.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OIL PAN
SUB-ASSY
Install the 2 magnets in the oil pan.
Apply seal packing or equivalent to 18 bolts.
Seal packing:
THREE BOND 2430 or equivalent
D25674
(c)
Install a new gasket, oil pan and 18 bolts to the transaxle
case.
Torque: 7.6 N⋅m (77 kgf⋅cm, 67 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Because the bolts should be seal bolts, apply seal packing
to bolts and tighten them within 10 minutes after application.
C83111
11.
12.
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3229
40-51
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (U241E)
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (U241E)
40065-09
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
(a)
(b)
4.
5.
REMOVE FRONT WHEELS
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
Remove the drain plug, gasket and drain ATF.
Install a new gasket and drain plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST
6.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSAXLE HOUSING OIL SEAL
Using SST, pull out the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
7.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL
Using SST, pull out the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
D25827
SST
(a)
D25828
8.
(a)
SST
(b)
INSTALL TRANSAXLE HOUSING OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09316-6001 1 (09316-00011)
Oil seal drive in depth: 0 0.5 mm (0 0.020 in.)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
D25829
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3237
40-52
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
9.
(a)
(b)
-
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (U241E)
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09649-17010, 09950-70010 (09951-07150)
Oil seal drive in depth: 0 0.5 mm (0 0.020 in.)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
D25830
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEELS
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3238
40-53
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (U140F)
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (U140F)
4005W-06
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
When replacing the front differential oil seal (LH) or (RH), perform step 1 to 11 or 12 to 21 respectively.
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEELS
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
3.
DRAIN AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
(a) Remove the drain plug, gasket and drain ATF.
(b) Install a new gasket and drain plug.
Torque: 49 N⋅m (500 kgf⋅cm, 36 ft⋅lbf)
4.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
5.
SST
(a)
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL
Using SST, pull out the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
D25835
6.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09726- 27012 (09726- 02041), 09950- 70010
(09951-07200)
Oil seal drive in depth: 0 0.5 mm (0 0.020 in.)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
D25836
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT WHEELS
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (SEE PAGE 14-24 )
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
REMOVE TRANSVERSE ENGINE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
REMOVE TRANSFER ASSY (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3239
40-54
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL (U140F)
15.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSAXLE HOUSING OIL SEAL
Using a screw driver with vinyl tape wound around its tip,
remove the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the housing.
Vinyl Tape
D25618
16.
(a)
A
(b)
INSTALL TRANSAXLE HOUSING OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09309-37010
Oil seal drive in depth:
6.0 0.5 mm (0.236 0.020 in.)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
D25837
17.
18.
19.
20.
INSTALL TRANSVERSE ENGINE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
INSTALL TRANSFER ASSY (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (SEE PAGE 14-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3240
40-59
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (ATM)
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (ATM)
40067-10
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
2.
(a)
(b)
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
CHECK SHIFT LOCK OPERATION
Shift the shift lever to P position.
Turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
Check that the shift lever cannot be shifted to any other positions that P.
Turn the ignition switch ON, depress the brake pedal and check that the shift lever can be shifted to
any other positions.
CHECK SHIFT LOCK RELEASE BUTTON OPERATION
Using a small screwdriver, remove the shift lock release cover.
When operating the shift lever with the shift lock release button pressed, check that the lever can be
shifted to any position other than P.
CHECK KEY INTERLOCK OPERATION
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Depress the brake pedal and shift the shift lever to any other position than P.
Check that the ignition key cannot be turned to LOCK.
Shift the shift lever to P position, turn the ignition key to LOCK and check that the ignition key can be
removed.
4.
INSPECT SHIFT LOCK CONTROL UNIT ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage at each terminal.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the shift lock control unit assembly connector.
ACC
IG
STP
KLS+
E
C82814
Terminal
Measuring Condition
Voltage (V)
1 (ACC) - 3 (E)
Ignition switch ACC
10 - 14
1 (ACC) - 3 (E)
Ignition switch OFF
0
2 (STP) - 3 (E)
Depress brake pedal
10 - 14
2 (STP) - 3 (E)
Release brake pedal
0
4 (KLS+) - 3 (E)
(1) Ignition switch ACC and P position
(2) Ignition switch ACC and except P position
(3) Ignition switch ACC and except P position (After approx. 1 second)
0
7.5 - 11
6-9
5 (IG) - 3 (E)
Ignition switch ON
10 - 14
5 (IG) - 3 (E)
Ignition switch OFF
0
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3245
40-60
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
(b)
-
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (ATM)
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance at terminal
E (3) and body ground.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the shift lock control unit assembly connector.
ACC
IG
STP
KLS+
E
C82814
Terminal
1 (E) - Body ground
Measuring Condition
Specified Value
Always
Continuity
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3246
40-73
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY (ATM)
TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY (ATM)
4005X-06
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER RH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER LH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
BATTERY
AIR CLEANER ASSY
AIR CLEANER HOSE NO.1
7.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY
Remove the nut from the control shaft lever.
Disconnect the control cable from the control shaft lever.
(c)
Remove the clip and disconnect the control cable from
the control cable bracket.
(d)
Disconnect the control cable from the control cable
clamp.
D25414
D25415
D25416
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3259
40-74
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY (ATM)
(e)
Disconnect the cable end from the rod of the floor shift
assy.
(f)
Remove the 2 nuts.
(g)
(h)
Remove the 3 bolts.
Pull out the control cable from the body.
8.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY
Pull in the control cable to the body.
Install the 3 bolts.
Torque: 4.9 N⋅m (50 kgf⋅cm, 43 in.⋅lbf)
D25449
D25450
C83207
C83207
(c) Install the cable end, as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Install it with the uneven surface facing up.
D25449
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3260
40-75
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY (ATM)
(d)
Install the control cable and 2 nuts.
Torque: 11.8 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
(e)
Connect the control cable to the control cable clamp.
(f)
Temporarily install the control cable to the control shaft lever with nuts.
(g)
Install the control cable and clip to the bracket.
D25450
D25416
D25414
D25415
9.
10.
11.
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSY
ADJUST SHIFT LEVER POSITION (SEE PAGE 40-71 )
INSPECT SHIFT LEVER POSITION (SEE PAGE 40-71 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3261
40-72
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
KEY INTER LOCK SOLENOID (ATM)
KEY INTER LOCK SOLENOID (ATM)
4005S-05
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
4
KLS+
3
KLSD25589
INSPECT KEY INTER LOCK SOLENOID
Disconnect the solenoid connector.
Connect KLS+ (4) terminal to the batteries’ positive (+)
terminal, and KLS- (3) terminal to the battery negative (-)
terminal, and apply about 12V between KLS+ - KLS- terminals.
(c) Check that operation noise can be heard from the solenoid.
If the solenoid does not operate, replace the solenoid.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3258
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (U151E/U151F)
40-1 1
4016X-01
ADJUSTMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT SWITCH ASSY, NEUTRAL START
Apply the parking brake and turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Depress the brake pedal and check that the engine starts only when the shift lever is set in the N or
P position.
(c) Check that the back-up light is lit and the reverse warning buzzer sounds only when the shift lever is
set in the R position.
If a failure is found, check the park/neutral position switch for continuity.
Neutral
Basic Line
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Groove
ADJUST SWITCH ASSY, NEUTRAL START
Loosen the 2 bolts of park/neutral position switch and set
the shift lever to the N position.
Align the groove and neutral basic line.
Hold the switch in position and tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
After adjustment, perform the inspection described in
step 1.
C99453
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3197
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (U151E/U151F)
40-7
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY (U151E/U151F)
4016W-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
2.
(a)
(b)
SEPARATE TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY
Remove the nut from the control shaft lever.
Disconnect the control cable from the control shaft lever.
D30614
(c)
Remove the clip and disconnect the control cable from
the control cable bracket.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the resin guide pipe.
C89134
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY
Disconnect the park/neutral position switch connector.
Remove the nut, washer and control shaft lever.
(c)
Pry out the lock plate.
C99458
C99457
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3193
40-8
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (U151E/U151F)
(d)
Remove the lock nut and lock plate.
(e)
Remove the 2 bolts and pull out the park/neutral position
switch.
4.
(a)
INSTALL PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY
Install the park/neutral position switch to the manual valve
shaft.
Temporarily install the 2 bolts.
G25453
C99454
(b)
C99454
(c)
(d)
Place the lock plate and tighten the nut.
Torque: 6.9 N⋅m (70 kgf⋅cm, 61 in.⋅lbf)
Temporarily install the control shaft lever.
G25453
(e)
(f)
N
Turn the lever counterclockwise until it stops, then turn it
clockwise 2 notches.
Remove the control shaft lever.
D30919
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3194
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
Groove
-
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (U151E/U151F)
40-9
(g)
(h)
Align the groove with the neutral basic line.
Hold the switch in position and tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
(i)
Using a screwdriver, stake the nut with the lock plate.
(j)
(k)
Install the control shaft lever, washer and nut.
Torque: 13 N⋅m (130 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the park/neutral position switch connector.
5.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY
Install the control cable and clip to the bracket.
(b)
Temporarily install the control cable to the control shaft lever with the nut.
Neutral
Basic Line
C99456
C99457
C99458
C89134
D30614
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3195
40-10
6.
7.
8.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (U151E/U151F)
ADJUST SHIFT LEVER POSITION (SEE PAGE 40-71 )
INSPECT SHIFT LEVER POSITION (SEE PAGE 40-71 )
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-1 1)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3196
40-6
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (U241E/U140F)
4017L-01
ADJUSTMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY
Apply the parking brake and turn the ignition switch ON.
Depress the brake pedal and check that the engine starts only when the shift lever is set in N or P position and it does not start in other positions.
(c) Check that the back-up light is lit and the reverse warning buzzer sounds only when the shift lever is
set in R position and these do not function in other positions.
If a failure is found, check the park/neutral position switch for continuity.
2.
(a)
Neutral
Basic Line
(b)
(c)
(d)
Groove
ADJUST PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY
Loosen the 2 bolts of park/neutral position switch and set
the shift lever to the N position.
Align the groove and neutral basic line.
Hold the switch in position and tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
After adjustment, perform the inspection described in
step 1.
D25514
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3192
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (U241E/U140F)
40-3
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY (U241E/U140F)
4017K-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
2.
(a)
(b)
SEPARATE TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY
Remove the nut from the control shaft lever.
Disconnect the control cable from the control shaft lever.
(c)
Remove the clip and disconnect the control cable from
the control cable bracket.
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY
Remove the nut, washer and control shaft lever.
Pry out the lock plate and remove the manual valve shaft
nut.
Remove the 2 bolts and pull out the park/neutral position
switch.
D25414
D25415
(c)
D09636
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
INSTALL PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY
Install the park/neutral position switch to the manual valve
shaft.
Place a new lock plate and tighten the nut.
Torque: 6.9 N⋅m (70 kgf⋅cm, 61 in.⋅lbf)
Temporarily install the 2 bolts.
Temporarily install the control shaft lever.
D09639
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3189
40-4
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
(e)
(f)
-
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (U241E/U140F)
Turn the lever counterclockwise until it stops, then turn it
clockwise 2 notches.
Remove the control shaft lever.
D09641
Neutral
Basic Line
(g)
(h)
Align the groove with neutral basic line.
Hold the switch in position and tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
(i)
Using a screwdriver, stake the nut with the lock plate.
(j)
Install the control shaft lever, washer and nut.
Torque: 12.7 N⋅m (130 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
5.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE ASSY
Temporarily install the control cable to the control shaft lever with nuts.
Groove
D25513
D09643
D09644
D25414
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3190
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
(b)
-
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
ASSY (U241E/U140F)
40-5
Install the control cable and clip to the bracket.
D25415
6.
7.
8.
ADJUST SHIFT LEVER POSITION (See page 40-71 )
INSPECT SHIFT LEVER POSITION
INSPECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH ASSY (See page 40-6 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3191
40-49
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
OIL W/HOSE COOLER ASSY (U241E/U140F)
OIL W/HOSE COOLER ASSY (U241E/U140F)
4017J-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
(a)
4.
(a)
REMOVE RADIATOR GRILLE (See page 76-2 )
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page 76-2 )
SEPARATE OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE NO.1
Loosen the clip and separate the oil cooler hose.
SEPARATE TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER HOSE NO.1
Loosen the clip and separate the transmission oil cooler hose No. 1.
5.
(a)
REMOVE OIL W/HOSE COOLER ASSY
Remove the bolt, nut and oil cooler assy.
D25421
6.
INSTALL OIL W/HOSE COOLER ASSY
(a) Install the oil cooler assy, bolt A and nut B.
HINT:
After temporally tightening bolt A, tighten in order of nut B, bolt
A.
Torque: 7.0 N⋅m (71 kgf⋅cm, 62 in.⋅lbf)
B
A
D25421
7.
(a)
8.
(a)
9.
10.
INSTALL TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER HOSE NO.1
Install the transmission oil cooler hose No. 1 and clip.
INSTALL OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE NO.1
Install the oil cooler hose and clip.
ADD AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID
INSPECT AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID (See page 40-2 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3235
40-12
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U241E/U140F)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U241E/U140F)
40062-07
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
REMOVE ENGINE ASSY W/ TRANSAXLE (SEE PAGE 14-24 )
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
REMOVE TRANSVERSE ENGINE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE
PAGE 31-9 )
REMOVE TRANSFER ASSY (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
6.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET NO.2
Remove the bolt and control cable clamp.
7.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE WIRE HARNESS CLAMP
Disconnect the wire harness from the clamp.
Remove the 3 bolts and 2 clamps.
8.
(a)
SEPARATE WIRE HARNESS
Remove the wire harness.
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE STARTER ASSY
Remove the nut and disconnect the starter wire.
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 2 bolts and starter.
C83203
D25422
C83204
D25404
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3198
40-13
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
10.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U241E/U140F)
SEPARATE CONNECTOR
Disconnect the transmission wire connector.
Disconnect the park/neutral position switch connector.
Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
11.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET NO.1
Remove the bolt and oil cooler tube clamp.
Remove the 2 bolts and transmission control cable bracket.
D25403
12.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER TUBE SUB-ASSY
Remove the ATF level gauge.
Remove the bolt and oil filler tube.
Remove the O-ring from the oil filler tube.
13.
(a)
SST
14.
(a)
REMOVE OIL COOLER INLET TUBE NO.1
Using SST and spanner, disconnect the oil cooler inlet
tube.
SST 09023-12701
REMOVE OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE NO.1
Using SST and spanner, disconnect the oil cooler outlet
tube.
SST 09023-12701
D25405
15.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSVERSE
ENGINE ENGINE
MOUNTING BRACKET
Remove the 2 bolts and engine mounting bracket FR.
16.
(a)
REMOVE FLYWHEEL HOUSING UNDER COVER
Remove the flywheel housing under cover.
C83205
D25407
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3199
40-14
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U241E/U140F)
17.
(a)
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY
Turn the crankshaft to gain access and remove the 6 bolts
while holding the crankshaft pulley bolt with a wrench.
(b)
(c)
Remove the 9 bolts.
Separate and remove the automatic transaxle.
D25408
U241E
U140F
D32109
18.
19.
REMOVE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-29 )
SST 09350-32014 (09351-32010, 09351-32020)
20. INSTALL TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY
(a) Install the torque converter clutch to the automatic transaxle.
(b)
A
Using calipers, measure dimension A between the transaxle and the end surface of the drive plate.
C83051
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3200
40-15
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U241E/U140F)
(c)
Using calipers and a straight edge, measure the dimension B shown in the illustration and check that B is greater
than A measured in (b).
Standard: A + 1 mm or more
21.
(a)
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY
Install the automatic transaxle and 9 bolts to the engine.
Torque:
Bolt A: 64 N⋅m (650 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
Bolt B: 46 N⋅m (470 kgf⋅cm, 34 ft⋅lbf)
Bolt C: 37.2 N⋅m (379 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
Apply a few drops of adhesive to each 2 threads on the
tip of the 6 torque converter clutch mounting bolts.
Adhesive: Part No. 08833-00070 or equivalent
B
Dimension B
A
U241E:
C65911
A
B
A
B
C
U140F:
A
C
C
A
(b)
C
B
A
B
C
C
C
C
D25617
(c)
Install the 6 torque converter clutch mounting bolts.
Torque: 41 N⋅m (420 kgf⋅cm, 30 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
First install green colored bolt and then the 5 bolts.
D25408
22.
(a)
INSTALL FLYWHEEL HOUSING UNDER COVER
Install the flywheel housing under cover.
D25407
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3201
40-16
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
23.
(a)
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U241E/U140F)
INSTALL TRANSVERSE ENGINE ENGINE MOUNTING
BRACKET
Install the engine mounting bracket FR and 2 bolts to the
automatic transaxle.
Torque: 64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
C83205
24.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER TUBE SUB-ASSY
Coat a new O-ring with ATF, and install it to the oil filler tube.
Install the oil filler tube and bolt to the automatic transaxle.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Install the ATF level gauge.
25. INSTALL TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET NO.1
(a) Install the control cable bracket and 2 bolts.
Torque: 11.8 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
26.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL OIL COOLER INLET TUBE NO.1
Temporarily install the oil cooler outlet tube.
Temporarily install the oil cooler inlet tube.
(c)
Install the oil cooler tube clamp and bolt.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
C83206
HINT:
Install them so that the oil cooler tube cushion is positioned as
illustrated.
D25410
(d)
SST
Using SST and spanner, tighten the oil cooler inlet tube.
SST 09023-12701
Torque: 34.3 N⋅m (350 kgf⋅cm, 25 ft⋅lbf)
D25411
27.
(a)
INSTALL OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE NO.1
Using SST and spanner, tighten the oil cooler outlet tube.
SST 09023-12701
Torque: 34.3 N⋅m (350 kgf⋅cm, 25 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3202
40-17
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
28.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U241E/U140F)
INSTALL STARTER ASSY
Install the starter and 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N⋅m (398 kgf⋅cm, 29 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the connecter.
Install the starter wire and nut.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
D25404
29.
(a)
INSTALL WIRE HARNESS
Install the wire harness and bolt.
Torque: 25.5 N⋅m (260 kgf⋅cm, 19 ft⋅lbf)
30.
(a)
INSTALL WIRE HARNESS CLAMP
Install the 2 clamps and 3 bolts.
Torque: 8.4 N⋅m (86 kgf⋅cm, 74 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the wire harness to the clamp.
C83204
(b)
D25422
31.
(a)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET NO.2
Install the control cable clamp and bolt.
Torque: 11.8 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
C83203
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
INSTALL TRANSFER ASSY (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
INSTALL TRANSVERSE ENGINE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE
PAGE 31-9 )
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL ENGINE ASSY W/ TRANSAXLE (SEE PAGE 14-24 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3203
40-18
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U151E/U151F)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U151E/U151F)
4012C-02
COMPONENTS
8.4 (86, 74 in.⋅lbf)
Bearing Bracket Hole Snap Ring
13 (133, 10)
8.4 (86, 74 in.⋅lbf)
Front Drive Shaft
Assy RH
Wire Harness Clamp
12 (122, 9)
Wire Harness
Clamp
32 (330, 24)
Transmission Control
Cable Bracket No.2
46 (470, 34)
64 (650, 47)
41 (418, 30)
Torque
Converter
Clutch Assy
Automatic
Transaxle Assy
x6
Front Drive
Shaft LH
Hole Snap Ring
37 (377, 27)
7.8 (80, 69 in.⋅lbf)
5.5 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Flywheel Housing
Under Cover
O-Ring
Transmission
Oil Level Gauge sub-assy
Front Drive
Shaft Assy LH
Transmission
Oil Filler tube
sub-assy
Automatic transmission
oil coole tube clamp
Transmission
Control Cable
Bracket No.1
Starter Assy
5.4 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Oil Cooler
Outlet
Tube No.1
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
12 (122, 9)
Oil Cooler Inlet
Tube No.1
Engine Mounting
Bracket FR
37 (377, 27)
64 (653, 47)
34 (347, 25)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
D31755
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3204
40-19
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U151E/U151F)
13 (133, 10)
Front Drive Shaft Assy RH
8.4 (86, 74 in.⋅lbf)
Front Drive Shaft RH
Hole Snap Ring
8.4 (86, 74 in.⋅lbf)
Wire Harness Clamp
12 (122, 9)
Transmission Control
Cable Bracket No.2
34 (350, 25)
Wire Harness
Clamp
Transfer Stiffener
Plate RH
69 (700, 51)
46 (470, 34)
64 (650, 47)
Transfer
Assy
41 (418, 30)
x6
Torque
Converter
Clutch Assy
37 (377, 27)
5.5 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
7.8 (80, 69 in.⋅lbf)
69 (700, 51)
Transmission Oil Filler
tube sub-assy
Front Drive
Shaft Assy LH
Flywheel
Housing Under
Cover
Automatic transmission
Oil cooler tube clamp
O-Ring
Transmission Oil Level
Gauge sub-assy
Transmission
Control Cable
Bracket No.1
5.4 (55, 48 in.⋅lbf)
Front Drive Shaft LH
Hole Snap Ring
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
12 (122, 9)
Oil Cooler Inlet
Tube No.1
34 (347, 25)
Oil Cooler Outlet
Tube No.1
Engine Mounting
Bracket No.1
Starter Assy
64 (653, 47)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
37 (377, 27)
Non-reusable part
D31756
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3205
40-20
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U151E/U151F)
4016Y-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
REMOVE ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST 09520-01010, 09520-24010 (09520-32040)
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (2WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST 09520-01010, 09520-24010 (09520-32040)
5.
(a)
REMOVE TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET NO.2
Remove the bolt and transmission control cable bracket
No.2.
G25454
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE WIRE HARNESS CLAMP
Disconnect the wire harnesses from the clamps.
Remove the 3 bolts and 2 clamps.
7.
(a)
DISCONNECT WIRE HARNESS
Remove the bolt and wire harness.
8.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE STARTER ASSY
Remove the nut and disconnect the starter wire.
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 2 bolts and starter assy.
D25422
G25456
D30464
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3206
40-21
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
Transmission
Wire Connector
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U151E/U151F)
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
Disconnect the transmission wire connector.
Disconnect the park/neutral position switch connector.
Disconnect the 2 speed sensor connectors.
10.
REMOVE TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET NO.1
Remove the bolt and automatic transmission oil cooler
tube clamp.
Remove the 2 bolts and transmission control cable bracket No.1.
Park/neutral Position Switch Connector
Speed Sensor Connectors
D30864
(a)
(b)
C91736
11.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER TUBE
SUB-ASSY
Remove the transmission oil level gauge sub-assy.
Remove the bolt and transmission oil filler tube sub-assy.
Remove the O-ring from the transmission oil filler tube
sub-assy .
C91737
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3207
40-22
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U151E/U151F)
(d)
Disconnect the breather hose from the wire harness
bracket.
12.
(a)
REMOVE OIL COOLER INLET TUBE NO.1
Using SST and a spanner, disconnect the oil cooler inlet
tube No.1.
SST 09023-12701
D31339
SST
C88047
13.
(a)
REMOVE OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE NO.1
Using SST and a spanner, disconnect the oil cooler outlet tube No.1.
SST 09023-12701
14.
(a)
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET FR
Remove the 3 bolts and engine mounting bracket FR.
15.
(a)
REMOVE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY
Remove the 2 bolts and flywheel housing under cover.
D30470
D30471
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3208
40-23
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
(b)
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U151E/U151F)
Turn the crankshaft to gain access and remove the 6 bolts
while holding the crankshaft pulley bolt with a wrench.
HINT:
There will be one green colored bolt.
D30472
U151E:
(c)
(d)
Remove the 8 bolts.
Separate and remove the automatic transaxle.
16.
REMOVE TRANSFER STIFFENER PLATE RH (4WD
DRIVE TYPE)
Remove the 5 bolts and transfer stiffener plate RH.
U151F:
D32008
(a)
G25458
17.
18.
19.
REMOVE TRANSFER ASSY (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
REMOVE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY
INSPECT TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 40-2 )
SST 09350-32014 (09351-32010, 09351-32020)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3209
40-24
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U151E/U151F)
20.
(a)
INSTALL TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH ASSY
Install the torque converter clutch to the automatic transaxle.
(b)
Using vernier calipers and a straight edge, measure the
dimension ”A” between the transaxle fitting part of the engine and the converter fitting part of the drive plate.
A
D31087
G26518
(c)
Using vernier calipers and a straight edge, measure the
dimension ”B” shown in the illustration and check that ”B”
is greater than ”A”, previously measured. See step 20 (b).
Standard: A + 1 mm or more
NOTICE:
Remember to minus the thickness of the straight edge.
B
Dimension B
21.
D31341
INSTALL TRANSFER ASSY (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 31-9 )
U151E:
22.
(a)
A
A
A
A
A
(b)
B
C
A
A
U151F:
C
INSTALL AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION W/TRANSFER
Install the automatic transaxle w/ transfer with the 8 bolts
to the engine.
Torque:
Bolts A: 64 N⋅m (650 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
Bolt B: 46 N⋅m (470 kgf⋅cm, 34 ft⋅lbf)
Bolts C: 37 N⋅m (377 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
Apply a few drops of adhesive to each of 2 threads on the
tip of the 6 torque converter clutch mounting bolts.
Adhesive: Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324
or equivalent
A
A
A
B
C
C
D32008
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3210
40-25
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
(c)
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U151E/U151F)
Install the 6 torque converter clutch mounting bolts.
Torque: 41 N⋅m (418 kgf⋅cm, 30 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
First install the green colored bolt and then the remaining 5
bolts.
D30472
(d)
Install the flywheel housing under cover to the automatic
transaxle with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N⋅m (80 kgf⋅cm, 69 in⋅lbf)
23.
INSTALL TRANSFER STIFFENER PLATE RH (4WD
DRIVE TYPE)
Install the transfer stiffener plate RH with 5 bolts to the
transfer and engine mounting bracket RR.
Torque: 34 N⋅m (350 kgf⋅cm, 25 ft⋅lbf)
D30471
(a)
G25458
24.
(a)
25.
(a)
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET FR
Install the engine mounting bracket FR and 3 bolts to the
automatic transaxle.
Torque: 64 N⋅m (653 kgf⋅cm, 47 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION OIL FILLER TUBE
SUB-ASSY
Coat a new O-ring with ATF, and install it to the transmission oil filler tube sub-assy.
D30470
(b)
Install the transmission oil filler tube sub-assy and bolt to
the automatic transaxle.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
C88135
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3211
40-26
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U151E/U151F)
(c) Install the transmission oil level gauge sub-assy.
NOTICE:
The breather hose should be on the left side of the vehicle.
(d) Connect the breather hose to the wire harness bracket.
D31339
26.
(a)
27.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET NO.1
Install the transmission control cable bracket No.1 and 2
bolts.
Torque: 12 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL OIL COOLER INLET TUBE NO.1
Temporarily install the oil cooler outlet tube No.1.
Temporarily install the oil cooler inlet tube No.1.
C88278
(c)
Install the automatic transmission oil cooler tube clamp
and bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
HINT:
Install the automatic transmission oil cooler tube clamp and bolt
so that the oil cooler tube cushion is positioned as illustrated.
C91745
(d)
Using SST and a spanner, tighten the oil cooler inlet tube
No.1.
SST 09023-12701
Torque: 34 N⋅m (347 kgf⋅cm, 25 ft⋅lbf)
SST
C92540
28.
(a)
INSTALL OIL COOLER OUTLET TUBE NO.1
Using SST and a spanner, tighten the oil cooler outlet tube No.1.
Torque: 34 N⋅m (347 kgf⋅cm, 25 ft⋅lbf)
SST 09023-12701
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3212
40-27
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
Transmission
Wire Connector
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U151E/U151F)
29.
(a)
(b)
(c)
CONNECT CONNECTOR
Connect the transmission wire connector.
Connect the park/neutral position switch connector.
Connect the 2 speed sensor connectors.
30.
(a)
INSTALL STARTER ASSY
Install the starter assy and 2 bolts.
Torque: 37 N⋅m (377 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the connector.
Install the starter wire and nut.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Park/neutral Position Switch Connector
Speed Sensor Connectors
D30864
(b)
(c)
D30464
31.
(a)
INSTALL WIRE HARNESS
Install the wire harness and bolt.
Torque: 13 N⋅m (130 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
32.
(a)
INSTALL WIRE HARNESS CLAMP
Install the 2 clamps and 3 bolts.
Torque: 8.4 N⋅m (86 kgf⋅cm, 74 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the wire harnesses to the clamps.
G25456
(b)
D25422
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3213
40-28
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION / TRANS
33.
(a)
-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ASSY (U151E/U151F)
INSTALL TRANSMISSION CONTROL CABLE
BRACKET NO.2
Install the transmission control cable bracket No.2 with
the bolt.
Torque: 12 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
G25454
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (2WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSY RH (4WD DRIVE TYPE) (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
INSTALL ENGINE ASSEMBLY WITH TRANSAXLE (SEE PAGE 14-149 )
RESET MEMORY (SEE PAGE 05-1005 )
PERFORM INITIALIZATION (SEE PAGE 01-4 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3214
50-3
STEERING COLUMN
-
STEERING SYSTEM
5004Y-02
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
Maximum
Freeplay
1.
(a)
(b)
CHECK STEERING WHEEL FREEPLAY
Stop the vehicle and align the tires straight ahead.
Turn the steering wheel gently right and left, and check
the steering wheel free play.
Maximum freeplay: 30 mm (1.18 in.)
If the free play exceeds the maximum, replace the steering intermediate shaft sub-assy or steering gear.
30 mm (1.18 in.)
F46831
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3264
50-1
STEERING COLUMN
-
STEERING SYSTEM
STEERING SYSTEM
5004W-02
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
2.
(a)
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR STEERING SYSTEM
Care must be taken when replacing parts. Incorrect replacement may affect the performance of the
steering system and result in a driving hazard.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR SRS AIRBAG SYSTEM
The HIGH LANDER is equipped with SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) such as the driver airbag
and front passenger airbag. Failure to carry out service operation in the correct sequence could cause
the SRS to unexpectedly deploy during servicing, possibly leading to a serious accident. Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read the precautionary notice for the supplemental restraint system (see page 60-1 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3262
50-2
STEERING COLUMN
-
STEERING SYSTEM
5004X-03
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely
cause of the problem. Check each part in the order shown. If necessary, repair or replace these parts.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
1. Tires (Improperly inflated)
2. Power steering fluid level (Low)
3. Drive belt (Loose)
9. Power steering link assy
28-1
51-3
14-5
14-125
26-7
26-20
51-8
51-17
51-28
Poor return
1.
2.
3.
4.
Tires (Improperly inflated)
Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
Steering column (Binding)
Power steering link assy
28-1
26-7
51-28
Excessive play
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Steering system joints (Worn)
Suspension arm ball joints (Worn)
Intermediate shaft, Sliding yoke (Worn)
Front wheel bearing (Worn)
Power steering link assy
26-20
30-38
51-28
Hard steering
Abnormal noise
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
Steering system joints (Worn)
Suspension arm ball joints (Worn)
Steering column (Binding)
Power steering vane pump
1. Power steering fluid level (Low)
2. Steering system joints (Worn)
3. Power steering vane pump
51-3
51-8
51-17
51-28
4. Power steering link assy
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3263
50-4
STEERING COLUMN
-
STEERING SYSTEM
5004Z-02
REPAIR
1.
(a)
Steering Wheel
Masking Tape
Steering Column
Upper Cover
STEERING OFF CENTER REPAIR PROCEDURE
Inspect steering wheel off center.
(1) Apply masking tape on the top center of the steering
wheel and steering column upper cover.
(2) Drive the vehicle in a straight line for 100 meters at
a constant speed of 35 mph (56 km/h), and hold the
steering wheel to maintain the course.
F16015
(3)
Steering Column
Upper Cover
Draw a line on the masking tape as shown in the illustration.
Marked Line
Steering Wheel
Masking
Tape
F16016
(4) Turn the steering wheel to the center position.
HINT:
Look at the upper surface of the steering wheel, steering spoke
and SRS airbag line to find the center position.
(5) Draw a new line on the masking tape on the steering
wheel as shown in the illustration.
(6) Measure the distance between the 2 lines on the
masking tape on the steering wheel.
Steering Column
Upper Cover
Marked Line
Steering Wheel
F16017
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3265
50-5
STEERING COLUMN
-
STEERING SYSTEM
(7) Convert the measured distance to steering angle.
Measured distance 1 mm (0.04 in.) = Steering angle of
approximately 1 degree.
HINT:
Make a note of the steering angle.
(b) Adjust steering angle.
(1)
(2)
Draw a line on the RH and LH tie rod ends and rack
ends respectively where it can be easily seen.
Using a paper gauge, measure the distance from
the RH and LH tie rod ends to the rack end screws.
HINT:
Marked Line
Measure both the RH and LH sides.
Make a note of the measured values.
R00429
(3)
F16018
Remove the RH and LH boot clips from the rack
boots.
(4) Loosen the RH and LH lock nuts.
(5) Turn the RH and LH rack ends by the same amount
(but in different directions) according to the steering
angle.
One 360 degree turn of rack end (1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
horizontal movement) eguals to 12 degrees of steering angle.
(6) Tighten the RH and LH lock nuts by the specified
torque.
Torque: 74 N·m (750 kgf·cm, 54 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the difference in length between the RH and
LH tie rod ends and rack end screws are within 1.5 mm
(0.059 in.).
(7) Install the RH and LH boot clips.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3266
50-6
STEERING COLUMN
-
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
5009G-01
COMPONENTS
Horn Button Assy
8.8 (90, 78 in.⋅lbf)
50 (510, 37)
Steering Wheel Cover
Lower No.2
Steering Column
Cover UPR
Spiral Cable
Sub-assy
Steering Wheel Assy
Steering Wheel Cover
Lower No.2
8.8 (90, 78 in.⋅lbf)
Windshield
Wiper Switch
Assy
Head Lamp Dimmer
Switch Assy
Steering
Column Assy
Steering Column
Cover LWR
35 (360, 26)
21 (210, 15)
Steering Intermediate
Shaft Sub-assy
21 (210, 15)
35 (360, 26)
Clamp
Instrument Panel Finish
Panel Sub-assy Lower
Instrument Panel
Insert Sub-assy
LWR LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
F46486
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3267
50-7
STEERING COLUMN
-
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
Key Cylinder Lamp Assy
(w/ Illuminated Entry System)
Transponder Key Amplifier
(w/ Engine Immobiliser System)
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder Assy
Key Inter Lock
Solenoid
Tapered-Head Bolt
Steering Column Clamp Upper
Steering Column Upper w/ Switch
Bracket Assy
Steering Column Tube
Un-lock Warning Switch
Assy
Ignition or
Starter Switch
Steering Main Shaft
Snap Ring (Outer Side)
Steering Main
Shaft Bushing
Steering Main
Shaft Snap Ring
(Inner Side)
Steering Main Shaft Assy
Non-reusable part
F46487
F46487
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3268
50-8
STEERING COLUMN
-
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
5009H-01
OVERHAUL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.2 (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
REMOVE HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
6.
(a)
(b)
Matchmarks
(c)
SST
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSY
Remove the steering wheel assy set nut.
Place matchmarks on the steering wheel assy and main
shaft assy.
Using SST, remove the steering wheel assy.
SST 09950- 50013 (09951- 05010, 09952- 05010,
09953-05020, 09954-05021)
F40348
7.
(a)
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER LWR
Remove the 3 screws and steering column cover LWR.
H40197
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
STEERING COLUMN COVER UPR
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-26 )
HEADLAMP DIMMER SWITCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 65-25 )
WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 66-16 )
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY LOWER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
INSTRUMENT PNL INSERT SUB-ASSY LWR LH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
14.
B
(a)
(b)
SEPARATE STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
SUB-ASSY
Loosen the bolt A and remove the clamp from the steering
intermediate shaft sub-assy.
Loosen the bolt B.
A
F46489
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3269
50-9
STEERING COLUMN
(c)
Matchmarks
(d)
-
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
Place matchmarks on the steering intermediate shaft
sub-assy and steering gear assy.
Remove the bolt and separate the steering intermediate
shaft sub-assy.
F40352
15.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN ASSY
Separate the connectors and wire harness clamps.
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and steering column assy from
the instrument panel reinforcement assy.
16.
REMOVE STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
SUB-ASSY
Place matchmarks on the steering intermediate shaft
sub-assy and steering shaft.
Remove the bolt and steering intermediate shaft subassy.
F46490
(a)
(b)
Matchmarks
17.
F46491
REMOVE KEY CYLINDER LAMP ASSY (W/ ILLUMINATED ENTRY SYSTEM)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3270
50-10
STEERING COLUMN
-
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
18.
F46482
REMOVE TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER (W/
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM)
(a) Widen the claw hung on the upper bracket by approx. 1.0
mm (0.039 in.) using a screwdriver.
(b) Pull the transponder key amplifier toward the rear of the
vehicle with the claw open.
NOTICE:
Take care not to use excessive force to prevent the case
from being damaged.
19.
(a)
INSPECT STEERING MAIN SHAFT ASSY
Measure the steering main shaft length.
Standard length: 504.5 1 mm (19.862 0.039 in.)
If the length is out of specification, replace the steering column
assy with a new one.
F46495
20.
Screw Extractor
(a)
(b)
(c)
F46492
21.
22.
(a)
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN UPPER W/SWITCH
BRACKET ASSY
Using a centering punch, mark the center of the 2 tapered-head bolts.
Using a 3 to 4 mm (0.12 to 0.16 in.) drill, drill in to the 2
bolts.
Using a screw extractor, remove the 2 bolts and steering
column upper w/ switch bracket assy.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN CLAMP UPPER
REMOVE STEERING MAIN SHAFT ASSY
Using a snap ring expander, remove the steering main
shaft snap ring (outer side).
F46493
(b)
Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the steering
main shaft assy and steering main shaft bushing.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the steering main shaft assy.
F46494
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3271
50-1 1
STEERING COLUMN
-
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
(c)
Using a snap ring expander, remove the steering main
shaft snap ring (inner side).
23.
(a)
REMOVE IGNITION SWITCH LOCK CYLINDER ASSY
Place the ignition switch lock cylinder assy at the ACC
position.
Push down the stop pin with a screwdriver, and pull out
the cylinder assy.
F40490
(b)
F46483
24.
(a)
(b)
Claws
REMOVE UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY
Separate the un-lock warning switch assy connector
from the ignition or starter switch assy.
Remove the un-lock warning switch assy by pushing up
the center part and releasing the 2 claws.
F46484
(c)
(d)
Disengage the secondary locking device.
Using a small screwdriver, disengage the locking lug of
the terminals 2 and 4, and pull the terminals out from the
un-lock warning switch assy rear side.
F46322
25.
(a)
26.
(a)
27.
(a)
28.
(a)
REMOVE KEY INTER LOCK SOLENOID
Remove the 2 screws and solenoid from the steering column bracket assy.
REMOVE IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSY
Remove the 2 screws and ignition or starter switch assy from the steering column bracket assy UPR.
INSTALL IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSY
Install the ignition or starter switch assy to the steering column bracket assy UPR with the 2 screws.
INSTALL KEY INTER LOCK SOLENOID
Install the solenoid to the steering column bracket assy with the 2 screws.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3272
50-12
STEERING COLUMN
29.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
INSTALL UN-LOCK WARNING SWITCH ASSY
Install the un-lock warning switch assy.
Connect the terminals 2 and 4 of the un-lock warning
switch assy connector.
Connect the un-lock warning switch assy connector to
the ignition or starter switch assy.
F46323
30.
(a)
(b)
31.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL IGNITION SWITCH LOCK CYLINDER ASSY
Make sure the ignition switch lock cylinder assy at the ACC position.
Install the ignition switch lock cylinder assy.
INSPECT STEERING LOCK OPERATION
Check that the steering lock mechanism is activated when removing the key.
Check that the steering lock mechanism is deactivated when inserting the key and turning it to ACC
position.
HINT:
If there is any abnormality, replace the ignition switch lock cylinder assy.
32.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL STEERING MAIN SHAFT ASSY
Using a snap ring expander, install a new steering main
shaft snap ring (inner side) to the steering main shaft
assy.
Install the steering main shaft assy to the steering column
tube.
F46498
(c)
Using a snap ring expander, install a new steering main
shaft snap ring (outer side) to the steering main shaft
assy.
F46493
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3273
50-13
STEERING COLUMN
-
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
33.
(a)
INSTALL STEERING MAIN SHAFT BUSH
Using SST and a hammer, install a new steering main
shaft bushing.
SST 09608-06041
34.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN UPPER W/SWITCH
BRACKET ASSY
Temporarily install the steering column upper w/ switch
bracket assy and steering column upper clamp with 2 new
tapered-head bolts.
Tighten the 2 tapered-head bolts until the bolt heads
break off.
SST
F46499
(a)
(b)
F46500
35.
INSTALL KEY CYLINDER LAMP ASSY (W/ ILLUMINATED ENTRY SYSTEM)
36.
F46485
INSTALL TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER (W/
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM)
(a) Align the transponder key amplifier with the installation
position of the upper bracket with the amplifier inclined.
(b) Push the transponder key amplifier up and connect it to
the upper bracket.
NOTICE:
Take care not to push the amplifier up with excessive force
to prevent it from being damaged.
37.
Matchmarks
(a)
(b)
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN STEERING INTERMEDIATE
SHAFT SUB-ASSY
Align the matchmarks on the steering intermediate shaft
sub-assy and steering main shaft assy.
Temporarily install the steering intermediate shaft subassy with the bolt.
F46491
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3274
50-14
STEERING COLUMN
38.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN ASSY
Install the steering column assy with the 2 bolts and nuts.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (210 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the connectors.
Connect the wire harness clamps to the steering column
tube.
F46490
39.
Matchmarks
(a)
(b)
CONNECT STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
SUB-ASSY
Align the matchmarks on the intermediate shaft sub-assy
and steering gear assy.
Install the bolt.
Torque: 35 N⋅m (360 kgf⋅cm, 26 ft⋅lbf)
F40352
(c)
A
(d)
Tighten the bolt A.
Torque: 35 N⋅m (360 kgf⋅cm, 26 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the clamp to the steering intermediate shaft
sub-assy and tighten the bolt B.
B
F46489
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
(a)
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-26 )
INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-26 )
CENTER SPIRAL CABLE (SEE PAGE 60-26 )
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER UPR
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER LWR
Install the steering column cover LWR with the 3 screws.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3275
50-15
STEERING COLUMN
46.
(a)
(b)
(c)
47.
48.
49.
-
STEERING COLUMN ASSY
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSY
Align the matchmarks on the steering wheel assy and steering main shaft assy.
Install the steering wheel assy set nut.
Torque: 50 N·m (510 kgf·cm, 37 ft·lbf)
Connect the connector.
INSTALL HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3276
51-7
POWER STEERING
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
VANE PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
510H6-01
COMPONENTS
Pressure Port Union
69 (704, 51)
O-Ring
Flow Control Valve
Power Steering
Oil Pressure Switch
21 (214, 15)
Flow Control Valve
Compression Spring
Vane Pump Housing Front
O-Ring
Power Steering Suction Port Union
12 (122, 9)
Vane Pump Housing Oil Seal
Vane Pump Housing
Rear
W/Pulley Shaft Sub-assy
Vane Pump
Shaft Snap Ring
O-Ring
Vane Pump Side Plate Front
O-Ring
X10
Vane Pump
Rotor
22 (224, 16)
Vane Pump Plate
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
Vane Pump Cam Ring
Non-reusable part
Power steering fluid
G30662
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3283
51-8
POWER STEERING
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
510H7-01
OVERHAUL
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten when using a vise.
When installing, coat the parts indicated by the arrows with power steering fluid
(see page 51-7 ).
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
2.
DRAIN POWER STEERING FLUID
3.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
4.
REMOVE FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (SEE PAGE 14-5 )
SST 09249-63010
5.
DISCONNECT OIL RESERVOIR TO PUMP HOSE NO.1
(a) Remove the clip and disconnect the oil reservoir to pump hose No.1.
NOTICE:
Take care not to spill fluid on the V belt.
Turn
Hold
6.
(a)
DISCONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSY
Using a wrench (27 mm) to hold the pressure port union,
remove the union bolt and the gasket.
7.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE VANE PUMP ASSY
Disconnect the connector from the oil pressure switch.
Using SST and a deep socket wrench (14 mm), loosen
bolt A.
SST 09249-63010
Remove bolt B and the vane pump assy.
F40529
A
(c)
SST
B
F40342
8.
(a)
FIX VANE PUMP ASSY
Using SST, hold the vane pump assy in a vise.
SST 09630-00014 (09631-00132)
SST
F41481
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE POWER STEERING SUCTION PORT UNION
Remove the bolt and the suction port union.
Remove the O-ring from the suction port union.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3284
51-9
POWER STEERING
10.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
REMOVE FLOW CONTROL VALVE
Remove the pressure port union.
Remove the O-ring from the pressure port union.
Remove the flow control valve and the compression
spring.
C84485
11. REMOVE POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
NOTICE:
If the oil pressure switch is dropped or damaged, replace it with a new one.
12.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE VANE PUMP HOUSING REAR
Remove the 4 bolts and the housing rear from the housing
front.
Remove the O-ring from the housing rear.
C84483
13.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE W/PULLEY SHAFT SUB-ASSY
Using 2 screwdrivers, remove the snap ring from the w/
pulley shaft sub-assy.
Remove the w/pulley shaft sub-assy.
16.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE VANE PUMP SIDE PLATE FRONT
Remove the side plate front from the housing front.
Remove the O-ring from the side plate front.
C57767
14.
(a)
(b)
15.
REMOVE VANE PUMP ROTOR
Remove the 10 vane pump plates.
Remove the vane pump rotor.
REMOVE VANE PUMP CAM RING
C65368
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3285
51-10
POWER STEERING
(c)
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Remove the O-ring from the housing front.
C65369
17. REMOVE VANE PUMP HOUSING OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the housing oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the housing front.
Cloth
D30331
18.
INSPECT VANE PUMP SHAFT AND BUSH IN
HOUSING FRONT
(a) Using a micrometer and a caliper gauge, measure the oil
clearance.
Maximum clearance: 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If it is more than the maximum, replace the vane pump assy.
F09875
19.
Thickness
(a)
INSPECT VANE PUMP ROTOR AND VANE PUMP
PLATES
Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the vane
pump plates.
Minimum thickness:
1.405 to 1.411 mm (0.05531 to 0.05555 in.)
D30648
(b)
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between a
side face of the vane pump rotor groove and the vane
plates.
Maximum clearance: 0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
If clearance exceeds maximum, replace the vane pump assy.
Feeler Gauge
R10282
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3286
51-1 1
POWER STEERING
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
20.
(a)
INSPECT FLOW CONTROL VALVE
Coat the flow control valve with power steering fluid and
check that it falls smoothly into the flow control valve hole
under its own weight.
If it lacks smoothness, replace the vane pump assy.
G30668
(b)
Check the flow control valve for leakage. Close one of the
holes and apply compressed air, 392 to 490 kPa (4 to 5
kgf/cm2, 57 to 71 psi), into the opposite side hole, and
confirm that air does not come out from the both end
holes.
If air leaks, replace the vane pump assy.
Compressed Air
Close
R07591
21.
Vernier Calipers
INSPECT FLOW CONTROL VALVE COMPRESSION
SPRING
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the free length of the
compression spring.
Minimum free length: 30.3 mm (1.193 in.)
If it is less than the minimum, replace the vane pump assy.
R08702
22. INSPECT PRESSURE PORT UNION
If the union seat in the pressure port union is severely damaged, it may cause fluid leakage. In that case,
replace the vane pump assy.
23.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL VANE PUMP HOUSING OIL SEAL
Coat a new housing oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
Using SST and a press, install a new housing oil seal.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00280), 09950- 70010
(09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the housing oil seal is installed in the correct direction.
SST
Oil Seal
F08480
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3287
51-12
POWER STEERING
VANE PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
24.
(a)
Vinyl Tape
C70122
-
D30334
INSTALL W/PULLEY SHAFT SUB-ASSY
Coat bushing surface of the housing front with power
steering fluid.
(b) Gradually insert the w/pulley shaft sub-assy from the
pulley side.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the housing oil seal lip in the housing
front.
After inserting the w/pulley shaft sub-assy, check
that the oil seal lip faces in the correct direction.
25. INSTALL VANE PUMP SIDE PLATE FRONT
(a) Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid and install it
into the housing front.
C65369
(b)
Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid and install it
onto the side plate front.
C65368
(c)
Align the dent of the side plate front with that of the housing front, and install the side plate front.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the side plate front is installed in the correct
direction.
Side Plate Front
Housing Front
F46198
26.
(a)
Housing Front
Cam Ring
Inscribed Mark
INSTALL VANE PUMP CAM RING
Align the dent of the cam ring with that of the side plate
front, and install the cam ring with the inscribed mark facing upward.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the cam ring is installed in the correct direction.
F46199
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3288
51-13
POWER STEERING
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
27. INSTALL VANE PUMP ROTOR
(a) Install the vane pump rotor.
HINT:
Vane pump rotor has no specific direction.
C95038
Inward
(b)
(c)
Coat 10 vane pump plates with power steering fluid.
Install the vane pump plates with the round end facing
outward.
28.
(a)
INSTALL VANE PUMP SHAFT SNAP RING
Using a screwdriver and a snap ring expander, install a
new snap ring to the w/pulley shaft sub-assy.
29.
(a)
INSTALL VANE PUMP HOUSING REAR
Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid and install it
onto the housing rear.
Align the straight pin of the housing rear with the dents of
the cam ring, side plate front and the housing front, and
install the housing rear with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 22 N⋅m (224 kgf⋅cm, 16 ft⋅lbf)
Outward
C95777
D30335
C57770
D30336
(b)
Housing
Rear
Housing
Front
Cam Ring
F46200
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3289
51-14
POWER STEERING
VANE PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
30.
(a)
INSPECT PRELOAD
Check that the pump rotates smoothly without abnormal
noise.
(b) Temporarily install the service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Thread diameter: 10 mm (0.39 in.)
Thread pitch: 1.25 mm (0.0492 in.)
Bolt length: 50 mm (1.97 in.)
(c) Using a torque wrench, check the pulley rotating torque.
C53369
Rotating torque:
0.27 N⋅m (2.8 kgf⋅cm, 2.4 in.⋅lbf) or less
If the rotating torque is not as specified, check the housing oil
seal.
INSTALL POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid and install it to the oil pressure switch.
Install the oil pressure switch onto the vane pump assy.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Service Bolt
31.
(a)
(b)
-
32.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
INSTALL FLOW CONTROL VALVE
Coat the compression spring and the flow control valve
with power steering fluid.
Install the compression spring and the flow control valve.
Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid and install it
onto the pressure port union.
Install the pressure port union.
Torque: 69 N⋅m (704 kgf⋅cm, 51 ft⋅lbf)
C84485
33.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL POWER STEERING SUCTION PORT UNION
Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid, and install it to the suction port union.
Install the suction port union with the bolt.
Torque: 12 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
34.
(a)
(b)
A
(c)
SST
B
Fulcrum Length
F40330
INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSY
Temporarily tighten bolt A to the vane pump assy.
Install the vane pump assy and bolt B.
Torque: 37 N⋅m (377 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
Using SST and a deep socket wrench (14 mm), tighten
bolt A.
SST 09249-63010
Torque: 26 N⋅m (264 kgf⋅cm, 19 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
(d)
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 345 mm
(13.58 in.).
This torque value is effective when SST is parallel to a
torque wrench.
Connect the connector to the oil pressure switch.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3290
51-15
POWER STEERING
Gasket
Pressure Feed
Tube Assy
Stopper
F41596
35.
(a)
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (2AZ-FE)
CONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSY
Install the pressure feed tube assy and a new gasket to
the vane pump assy with the union bolt.
HINT:
Make sure the stopper of the pressure feed tube assy touches
the housing front as shown in the illustration.
(b) Using a wrench (27 mm) to hold the pressure port union,
torque the union bolt.
Torque: 52 N⋅m (525 kgf⋅cm, 38 ft⋅lbf)
36. CONNECT OIL RESERVOIR TO PUMP HOSE NO.1
(a) Connect the oil reservoir to pump hose No.1 with the clip.
NOTICE:
Take care not to spill fluid on the V belt.
37. INSTALL FAN AND GENERATOR V BELT (SEE PAGE 14-5 )
SST 09249-63010
38. INSTALL FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
39. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
40. BLEED POWER STEERING FLUID (SEE PAGE 51-3 )
41. INSPECT FLUID LEAK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3291
51-3
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING SYSTEM
51018-17
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT DRIVE BELT
Visually check the belt for excessive wear, frayed cords,
etc.
If any defect is found, replace the drive belt.
HINT:
Cracks on the rib side of a belt are considered acceptable. Replace the belt if there are any missing ribs.
F40449
2.
(a)
(b)
F13530
Normal
Abnormal
CHECK FLUID LEVEL
Keep the vehicle level.
With the engine stopped, check the fluid level in the oil
reservoir. If necessary, add fluid.
Fluid: ATF DEXRON II or III
HINT:
When hot, check that the fluid level is within the HOT LEVEL
range on the reservoir.
If the fluid is cold, check that it is within the COLD LEVEL range.
(c) Start the engine and run at idle.
(d) Turn the steering wheel from lock to lock several times to
raise fluid temperature.
Fluid temperature: 75 to 80C (167 to 176F)
(e) Check for foaming or emulsification.
If foaming or emulsification is identified, bleed air in the power
steering system (see step 3).
F40897
(f)
5 mm (0.20 in.) or less
Engine Idling
Engine Stopped
R11786
With the engine idling, measure the fluid level in the reservoir.
(g) Stop the engine.
(h) Wait a few minutes and measure the fluid level in the reservoir again.
Maximum fluid level rise: 5 mm (0.20 in.) or less
If the fluid level rise exceeds the maximum, bleed air in the power steering system (see step 3).
(i)
Check the fluid level.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3279
51-4
POWER STEERING
Normal
Abnormal
F40897
-
POWER STEERING SYSTEM
3.
BLEED AIR IN POWER STEERING SYSTEM
NOTICE:
If you replace or separate the components for power steering oil pressure line, bleed air in the power steering system
after the operation.
(a) Idle the engine at 1,000 rpm or less until bubbles in the
fluid disappear. (Be sure not to turn the steering wheel.)
(b) When the bubbles disappear, slowly turn the steering
wheel from lock to lock 2 or 3 times.
(c) Repeat procedures (a) and (b) until the fluid level in the
reservoir becomes stable and bubbles disappear. If the
fluid level goes below the MAX line, add fluid.
(d) When the fluid level becomes stable, increase and decrease oil pressure 2 or 3 times for both left and right by
turning the steering wheel to the full lock positions and jiggling it there.
(e) Make sure that no bubbles exist in the reservoir. When
turning the steering wheel quickly or turning it from lock
to lock position, check that the steering wheel is not heavy
to turn and there is no abnormal noise or vibration.
(f)
When there are fluid leaks or abnormalities after bleeding
air, repair them and repeat procedures (a) to (e). If the abnormalities still exist, replace the related parts.
4.
CHECK STEERING FLUID PRESSURE
(a) Disconnect the pressure feed tube assy
(see page 30-3 ).
(b) Connect SST, as shown in the illustration on the next
page.
SST 09640-10010 (09641-01010, 09641-01020,
09641-01030)
NOTICE:
Check that the valve of the SST is in the open position.
(c) Bleed the power steering system.
(d) Start the engine and run at idle.
(e) Turn the steering wheel from lock to lock several times to
raise fluid temperature.
Fluid temperature: 75 to 80°C (167 to 176°F)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3280
51-5
POWER STEERING
Attachment
-
POWER STEERING SYSTEM
Attachment
SST
IN
OUT
F40336
(f)
Oil
Reservoir
PS Gear
Closed
PS Vane
Pump
SST
Z15498
Oil
Reservoir
PS Gear
Open
PS Vane
Pump
SST
With the engine idling, close the valve of the SST and observe the reading on the SST.
Fluid pressure:
7,800 to 8,300 kPa (80 to 85 kgf/cm2, 1,131 to 1,204 psi)
NOTICE:
Do not keep the valve closed for more than 10 seconds.
Do not allow the fluid temperature to become too
high.
(g)
(h)
With the engine idling, open the valve fully.
Measure the fluid pressure at engine speeds of 1,000 rpm
and 3,000 rpm.
Difference in fluid pressure:
490 kPa (5 kgf/cm2, 71 psi) or less
NOTICE:
Do not turn the steering wheel.
Z15499
(i)
Oil
Reservoir
Lock Position
PS Gear
Open
PS Vane
Pump
SST
Z15500
With the engine idling and the valve fully opened, turn the
steering wheel to the left or right full lock position.
Fluid pressure:
7,800 to 8,300 kPa (80 to 85 kgf/cm2, 1,131 to 1,204 psi)
NOTICE:
Do not keep the steering wheel in the full lock position
for more than 10 seconds.
Do not allow the fluid temperature to become too
high.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3281
51-6
POWER STEERING
(j)
(k)
(l)
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
F08858
-
POWER STEERING SYSTEM
Disconnect the SST.
SST 09640- 10010 (09641- 01010, 09641- 01020,
09641-01030)
Connect the pressure feed tube assy
(see page 30-3 ).
Bleed the power steering system (see step 3).
CHECK STEERING EFFORT
Center the steering wheel.
Remove the steering wheel pad (see page 60-17 ).
Start the engine and run it at idle.
Measure the steering effort in both directions.
Steering effort (Reference):
6.0 N·m (60 kgf·cm, 53 in.·lbf) or less
HINT:
Check tire type, pressure and road surface before making your
diagnosis.
(e) Tighten the steering wheel set nut.
Torque: 51 N·m (520 kgf·cm, 38 ft·lbf)
(f)
Install the steering wheel pad (see page 60-17 ).
(g) Clear the DTCs (see page 05-1215 ).
(h) Inspect the airbag warning light (see page 05-1207 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3282
51-1
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING SYSTEM
POWER STEERING SYSTEM
51016-08
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
2.
(a)
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR STEERING SYSTEM
Care must be taken when replacing parts. Incorrect replacement could affect the performance of the
steering system and result in a driving hazard.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR SRS AIRBAG SYSTEM
The vehicle is equipped with SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) such as the airbags. If service operation is not carried out properly, in a step by step fashion, sudden deployment of the airbags may
result in serious injury. Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read the precautionary notice for the supplemental restraint system
(see page 60-1 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3277
51-2
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING SYSTEM
51017-14
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate likely causes of the
problem in descending order. Check each part in order. Repair or replace parts as necessary.
Symptom
Suspected Area
1. Tires (Improperly inflated)
2. Power steering fluid level (Low)
3. Drive belt (Loose)
Hard steering
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
Steering system joints (Worn)
Suspension arm ball joints (Worn)
Steering column (Binding)
Power steering vane pump
See page
2AZ-FE:
3MZ-FE:
2AZ-FE:
3MZ-FE:
9. Power steering gear
28-1
51-3
14-1
14-121
26-7
26-20
50-8
51-8
51-17
30-3
Poor return
1.
2.
3.
4.
Tires (Improperly inflated)
Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
Steering column (Binding)
Power steering gear
28-1
26-7
50-8
30-3
Excessive freeplay
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Steering system joints (Worn)
Suspension arm ball joints (Worn)
Intermediate shaft, Sliding yoke (Worn)
Front wheel bearing (Worn)
Power steering gear
26-20
50-8
30-3
30-3
Abnormal noise
1. Power steering fluid level (Low)
2. Steering system joints (Worn)
3. Power steering vane pump
2AZ-FE:
3MZ-FE:
4. Power steering gear
51-3
51-8
51-17
30-3
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3278
51-16
POWER STEERING
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
VANE PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
510C9-07
COMPONENTS
Pressure Port Union
83 (846, 61)
Vane Pump
Housing Rear
O-Ring
Power Steering
Suction Port Union
Flow Control Valve
Vane Pump
Bracket Rear
Flow Control Valve
Compression Spring
O-Ring
24 (245, 18)
Gasket
13 (133, 10)
O-Ring
Vane Pump
Housing Front
43 (438, 32)
43 (438, 32)
24 (245, 18)
Pump Bracket
Front
Vane Pump
Housing Oil Seal
Vane Pump Pulley
Wave Washer
Vane Pump Shaft
X10
Vane Pump Cam Ring
Vane Pump Rotor
Vane Pump Plate
Vane Pump Shaft
Snap Ring
44 (449, 32)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
Vane Pump
Side Plate Rear
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Power steering fluid
D31109
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3292
51-17
POWER STEERING
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
510DV-05
OVERHAUL
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten when using a vise.
When installing, coat the parts indicated by the arrows with power steering fluid
(see page 51-16 ).
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
2.
DRAIN POWER STEERING FLUID
3.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
4.
DISCONNECT OIL RESERVOIR TO PUMP HOSE NO.1
(a) Remove the clip and disconnect the oil reservoir to pump hose No.1.
NOTICE:
Take care not to spill fluid on the V belt.
5.
REMOVE POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the oil pressure switch from the union bolt.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the oil pressure switch.
If the oil pressure switch is dropped or severely damaged, replace it with a new one.
6.
(a)
Turn
(b)
DISCONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSY
Using a wrench (24 mm) to keep the pressure port union,
remove the union bolt and the gasket.
Disconnect the pressure feed tube assy.
7.
(a)
REMOVE VANE PUMP V BELT
Loosen the 2 bolts and remove the vane pump V belt.
Keep
F41598
G25718
8.
(a)
REMOVE VANE PUMP ASSY
Remove the 2 bolts and the vane pump assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3293
51-18
POWER STEERING
9.
(a)
SST
(b)
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE VANE PUMP PULLEY
Using SST, keep the vane pump pulley from rotating and
loosen the nut.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-01000)
Remove the nut and the vane pump pulley from the vane
pump shaft.
F41600
10. REMOVE POWER STEERING SUCTION PORT UNION
(a) Remove the bolt and the suction port union.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the suction port union.
11. REMOVE FLOW CONTROL VALVE
(a) Remove the pressure port union.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the pressure port union.
(c) Remove the flow control valve and the compression spring.
12. REMOVE VANE PUMP BRACKET REAR
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and the vane pump bracket rear from the vane pump assy.
13. REMOVE VANE PUMP HOUSING REAR
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and the vane pump housing rear from the vane pump housing front.
(b) Remove the gasket.
(c) Remove the 2 O-rings from the vane pump housing rear.
14. REMOVE VANE PUMP SIDE PLATE REAR
(a) Remove the wave washer from the vane pump side plate rear.
HINT:
Make sure direction of the part.
(b) Remove the vane pump side plate rear.
HINT:
Make sure direction of the part.
15. REMOVE VANE PUMP CAM RING
HINT:
Make sure direction of the part.
16.
(a)
REMOVE VANE PUMP SHAFT SNAP RING
Using a screwdriver, remove the vane pump shaft snap
ring from the vane pump shaft.
C65312
17.
(a)
(b)
18.
REMOVE VANE PUMP ROTOR
Remove the 10 vane pump plates from the vane pump rotor.
Remove the vane pump rotor.
REMOVE VANE PUMP SHAFT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3294
51-19
POWER STEERING
19.
(a)
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
REMOVE PUMP BRACKET FRONT
Remove the bolt and the pump bracket front from the vane pump housing front.
20.
(a)
REMOVE VANE PUMP HOUSING OIL SEAL
Using a screwdriver, remove the vane pump housing oil
seal from the vane pump housing front.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the bushing of the vane pump
housing front.
Shop Rag
D30653
21.
INSPECT VANE PUMP SHAFT AND BUSH IN
HOUSING FRONT
(a) Using a micrometer and a caliper gauge, measure the oil
clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.027 to 0.054 mm (0.00106 to 0.00213 in.)
Maximum clearance: 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If clearance exceeds maximum, replace the vane pump assy.
(b) Check that there is no severe damage or wear on the
bushing of the vane pump housing front and the vane
pump shaft.
If necessary, replace the vane pump assy.
Caliper Gauge
Micrometer
Vane Pump Shaft
Bushing
Vane Pump
Housing Front
D30759
22.
Thickness
(a)
INSPECT VANE PUMP ROTOR AND VANE PUMP
PLATES
Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the vane
pump plates.
Minimum thickness:
1.397 to 1.403 mm ( 0.0550 to 0.0552 in.)
D30648
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3295
51-20
POWER STEERING
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(b)
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the vane pump rotor groove and the vane pump plate.
Maximum clearance: 0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
If clearance exceeds maximum, replace the vane pump assy.
Feeler Gauge
R10282
23.
(a)
INSPECT FLOW CONTROL VALVE
Coat the flow control valve with power steering fluid and
check that it falls smoothly into the flow control valve hole
under its own weight.
If it lacks smoothness, replace the vane pump assy.
R11288
(b)
Check the flow control valve for leakage. Close one of the
holes and apply compressed air, 392 to 490 kPa (4 to 5
kgf/cm2, 57 to 71 psi), into the opposite side hole, and
confirm that air does not come out from the both end
holes.
If air leaks, replace the vane pump assy.
Compressed Air
R07591
24.
Vernier Calipers
INSPECT FLOW CONTROL VALVE COMPRESSION
SPRING
(a) Using vernier calipers, measure the free length of the
compression spring.
Minimum free length: 32.24 mm (1.2693 in.)
If it is less than the minimum, replace the vane pump assy.
R08702
25. INSPECT PRESSURE PORT UNION
If the union seat in the pressure port union is severely damaged, it may cause fluid leakage. In that case,
replace the vane pump assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3296
51-21
POWER STEERING
SST
27.
(a)
VANE PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
26.
(a)
Press
Oil Seal
W03541
-
F41624
INSTALL VANE PUMP HOUSING OIL SEAL
Coat a new vane pump housing oil seal lip with power
steering fluid.
(b) Using SST and a press, install the vane pump housing oil
seal.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00330),
09950-70010 (09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the vane pump housing oil seal is installed
in the correct direction.
INSTALL PUMP BRACKET FRONT
Install the pump bracket front with the bolt.
Torque: 43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
28.
(a)
Bushing
F40339
Inscribed
Mark
INSTALL VANE PUMP SHAFT
Coat bushing surface of the vane pump housing front with
power steering fluid.
(b) Gradually insert the vane pump shaft from the pulley side.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the vane pump housing oil seal lip in
the vane pump housing front.
After installation, check the vane pump housing oil
seal lip.
29.
(a)
INSTALL VANE PUMP CAM RING
Align the holes of the vane pump cam ring with the 2
straight pins, and install the vane pump cam ring with the
inscribed mark facing upward.
Straight Pin
D30649
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3297
51-22
POWER STEERING
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
30.
(a)
INSTALL VANE PUMP ROTOR
Install the vane pump rotor with the inscribed mark facing
downward.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the vane pump rotor is installed in the correct direction.
Inscribed
Mark
Inscribed Mark
D30650
Inward
(b)
(c)
Coat all 10 vane pump plates with power steering fluid.
Install the vane pump plates with the round end facing
outward.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the vane pump plates are installed in the
correct direction.
Outward
C95777
D30335
31.
(a)
INSTALL VANE PUMP SHAFT SNAP RING
Using a snap ring expander, install a new vane pump
shaft snap ring onto the vane pump shaft.
32.
(a)
INSTALL VANE PUMP SIDE PLATE REAR
Align the groove of the vane pump cam ring with that of
the vane pump side plate rear to install.
D30651
Set
F41480
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3298
51-23
POWER STEERING
(b)
(c)
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Install the wave washer so that its protrusions fit into the
slots in the vane pump side plate rear.
Coat 2 new O-rings with power steering fluid and install
them onto the vane pump side plate rear.
R11292
Gasket
33. INSTALL VANE PUMP HOUSING REAR
(a) Install a new gasket to the vane pump housing front.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the gasket is installed with the cutout in the
correct position.
(b) Install the vane pump housing rear with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 24 N⋅m (245 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
Cutout Part
D30652
34.
(a)
(b)
(c)
MEASURE VANE PUMP ROTATION TORQUE
Check that the vane pump rotates smoothly without abnormal noise.
Temporarily install the nut to the vane pump shaft.
Using a torque wrench, check the vane pump rotating
torque.
Rotating torque:
0.27 N⋅m (2.8 kgf⋅cm, 2.4 in.⋅lbf) or less
F41573
35.
(a)
INSTALL VANE PUMP BRACKET REAR
Install the vane pump bracket rear with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 43 N⋅m (438 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
36. INSTALL FLOW CONTROL VALVE
(a) Coat the compression spring with power steering fluid and install it to the vane pump housing front.
(b) Coat the flow control valve with power steering fluid.
(c) Install the flow control valve to the vane pump housing front.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the flow control valve is installed in the correct direction.
(d) Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid and install it to the pressure port union.
(e) Install the pressure port union to the vane pump housing front.
Torque: 83 N⋅m (846 kgf⋅cm, 61 ft⋅lbf)
37. INSTALL POWER STEERING SUCTION PORT UNION
(a) Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid and install it to the suction port union.
(b) Install the suction port union with the bolt to the vane pump housing front.
Torque: 13 N⋅m (133 kgf⋅cm, 10 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3299
51-24
POWER STEERING
38.
(a)
(b)
SST
-
VANE PUMP ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL VANE PUMP PULLEY
Install the vane pump pulley to the vane pump shaft.
Using SST, keep the vane pump pulley from rotating and
install the nut.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-01000)
Torque: 44 N⋅m (449 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
F41600
39.
(a)
INSTALL VANE PUMP ASSY
Temporarily install the vane pump assy with the 2 bolts.
40.
(a)
A
(b)
B
(c)
INSTALL VANE PUMP V BELT
Install the vane pump V belt and adjust the V belt tension
(see page 14-121 ).
Torque the bolt A.
Torque: 43 N⋅m (440 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
Torque the bolt B.
Torque: 43 N⋅m (440 kgf⋅cm, 32 ft⋅lbf)
G25718
Pressure Feed
Tube Assy
Stopper
W03441
F41567
41.
(a)
CONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSY
Using a wrench (24 mm) to keep the pressure port union,
connect the pressure feed tube assy with the union bolt
and a new gasket.
Torque: 52 N⋅m (525 kgf⋅cm, 38 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the stopper of the pressure feed tube assy
touches the pump bracket front as shown in the illustration, then tighten the union bolt.
42.
(a)
INSTALL POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Install the oil pressure switch to the union bolt.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful to keep oil away from the connector.
(b) Connect the connector.
43. CONNECT OIL RESERVOIR TO PUMP HOSE NO.1
(a) Connect the oil reservoir to pump hose No.1.
(b) Install the clip.
44. INSTALL FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
45. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
46. BLEED POWER STEERING FLUID (SEE PAGE 51-3 )
47. INSPECT FLUID LEAK
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3300
51-25
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
510DW-03
COMPONENTS
Pressure Feed
Tube Assy
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Return Tube Assy
25 (250, 18)
*22 (230, 16)
25 (250, 18)
*22 (230, 16)
Steering Intermediate
Shaft Sub-assy
Return Tube Assy
49 (500, 36)
35 (360, 26)
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Tube Clamp
70 (714, 52)
Cotter Pin
74 (755, 55)
Power Steering Link Assy
Front Stabilizer Bar
Front Stabilizer
Link Assy RH
49 (500, 36)
Cotter Pin
16 (163, 12)
16 (163, 12)
Front Stabilizer
Link Assy LH
Front Stabilizer
Bracket No.1 RH
Front Stabilizer
Bracket No.1 LH
Front Stabilizer
Bar Bush No.1
Front Stabilizer
Bar Bush No.1
Front Stabilizer
Bracket No.2
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
74 (755, 55)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
* For use with SST
G30786
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3301
51-26
POWER STEERING
Steering Right Turn
Pressure Tube
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
Tube Clamp
21 (214, 15)
13 (127, 9)
*11 (116, 8)
O-Ring
O-Ring
Dust Cover
O-Ring
O-Ring
Control Valve
Housing
Power Steering
Control Valve
Upper Oil Seal
Steering Left Turn
Pressure Tube
Control Valve Upper
Bearing
13 (127, 9)
*11 (116, 8)
Control Valve Spacer
Power Steering Control Valve
Oil Seal
Rack Housing
Gasket
Compression
Spring
Rack Guide
Spring Cap
Lock Nut
69 (699, 51)
*51 (515, 38)
Rack Guide Spring Cap
Rack Guide
25 (250, 18)
Rack Housing Cap
59 (597, 43)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Precoated part
MP grease
Molybdenum disulfide lithium base grease
Power steering fluid
* For use with SST
D30948
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3302
51-27
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
Steering Rack Boot No.2 Clamp
Steering Rack Boot No.2
Lock Nut
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
74 (750, 54)
Steering Rack Boot
Clip
Tie Rod Assy LH
Rack Housing
Steering Rack End Sub-assy
84 (851, 62)
*60 (616, 45)
Claw Washer
Power Steering Rack
O-Ring
Power Piston Oil Seal
Power Steering Cylinder Tube Oil Seal
Claw Washer
Cylinder End Stopper
Steering Rack End Sub-assy
84 (851, 62)
*60 (616, 45)
Wire
Tie Rod Assy RH
Lock Nut
74 (750, 54)
Steering Rack
Boot No.1
ÇÇ
ÇÇ
Rack Bush
Oil Seal
O-Ring
Power Steering Rack Bush
Steering Rack Boot
Clip
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Silicon grease
Molybdenum disulfide lithium base grease
Power steering fluid
* For use with SST
Å
Steering Rack Boot No.1 Clamp
D30805
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3303
51-28
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
510DX-05
OVERHAUL
NOTICE:
When installing ,coat the parts indicated by arrows with power steering fluid or molybdenum disulfide lithium base grease (see page 51-25 ).
1.
INSPECT CENTER FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
3.
SEPARATE TIE ROD ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
SST 09628-6201 1
4.
SEPARATE TIE ROD ASSY RH
SST 09628-6201 1
HINT:
Perform the same procedure as for the LH.
5.
(a)
SEPARATE STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
SUB-ASSY
Fix the steering wheel with the seat belt in order to prevent
rotation.
HINT:
This operation is useful to prevent damage to the spiral cable.
F47048
(b)
B
(c)
(d)
A
Loosen bolt A and remove the clamp from the steering
column hole cover No.1.
Separate the steering column hole cover No.2 from the
steering column hole cover No.1.
Loosen bolt B.
F46489
(e)
Matchmarks
(f)
Put matchmarks on the steering intermediate shaft subassy and the steering link assy.
Remove the bolt and disengage the steering intermediate
shaft sub-assy.
F40352
6.
SEPARATE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
7.
SEPARATE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Perform the same procedure as for the LH.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3304
51-29
POWER STEERING
8.
(a)
(b)
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.1 LH
Remove the 2 bolts, the stabilizer bracket No.1 LH and
the stabilizer bracket No.2.
Remove the stabilizer bar bush No.1 from the stabilizer
bar.
D30771
9.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.1 RH
HINT:
Perform the same procedure as for the LH.
10.
(a)
(b)
DISCONNECT RETURN TUBE ASSY
Remove the tube clamp from the pressure feed tube assy.
Using SST, disconnect the return tube assy from the
steering link assy.
SST 09023-12701
(c)
Remove the nut and the return tube clamp.
11.
(a)
DISCONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSY
Using SST, disconnect the pressure feed tube assy from
the steering link assy.
SST 09023-12701
SST
D30607
F40331
SST
D30608
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3305
51-30
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(b)
Remove the bolt and the pressure feed tube clamp.
12.
(a)
REMOVE POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
Remove the 2 bolts, the nuts and the steering link assy.
13.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE STEERING LEFT TURN PRESSURE TUBE
Remove the tube clamp from the turn pressure tubes.
Using SST, disconnect the left turn pressure tube.
SST 09023-38201
Remove the 2 O-rings from the left turn pressure tube.
F40334
LH:
RH:
D29979
SST
(c)
O-ring
F40532
14.
REMOVE STEERING RIGHT TURN PRESSURE TUBE
SST 09023-38201
HINT:
Perform the same procedure as for the left turn pressure tube.
15.
(a)
SST
FIX POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
Using SST, secure the steering link assy.
SST 09612-00012
HINT:
Wrap the SST with tape before use, in order to prevent damaging the steering link assy.
F40533
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3306
51-31
POWER STEERING
16.
(a)
(b)
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
REMOVE TIE ROD ASSY LH
Put matchmarks on the tie rod assy LH and the rack end.
Loosen the lock nut and remove the tie rod assy LH and
the lock nut.
Matchmarks
F40050
17. REMOVE TIE ROD ASSY RH
HINT:
Perform the same procedure as for the LH.
18. REMOVE STEERING RACK BOOT CLIP
(a) Remove the 2 boot clips.
19. REMOVE STEERING RACK BOOT NO.2 CLAMP
(a) Using pliers, remove the rack boot No.2 clamp.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the boot.
20. REMOVE STEERING RACK BOOT NO.1 CLAMP
HINT:
Perform the same procedure as for the No.2 clamp.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the boot.
21. REMOVE STEERING RACK BOOT NO.2
22. REMOVE STEERING RACK BOOT NO.1
23.
(a)
REMOVE STEERING RACK END SUB-ASSY
Using a screwdriver and a hammer, unstake the claw
washer.
NOTICE:
Avoid any impact to the steering rack.
Claw
Washer
C83166
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3307
51-32
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(b)
Using 2 SST, remove the rack end RH and the claw washer.
SST 09922-10010
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922-10010, following the direction shown in the
illustration.
(c) Using 2 SST, hold the steering rack and remove the rack
end LH and the claw washer.
SST 09922-10010
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922-10010, following the direction shown in the
illustration.
RH:
SST
LH:
SST
F40558
24.
(a)
REMOVE RACK GUIDE
Using SST, remove the spring cap lock nut.
SST 09922-10010
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922-10010, following the direction shown in the
illustration.
SST
F40534
Rack Guide
Spring Cap
(b)
(c)
Using SST, remove the rack guide spring cap.
SST 09631-10021
Remove the compression spring and the rack guide.
SST
F40535
25.
(a)
Socket Wrench (27 mm)
REMOVE POWER STEERING CONTROL VALVE
Using a socket wrench (27 mm), remove the rack housing
cap.
F40536
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3308
51-33
POWER STEERING
SST
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(b)
Using SST, keep the control valve shaft and remove the
nut.
SST 09616-0001 1
(c)
Wrap vinyl tape around the spline of the control valve in
order to prevent damaging the oil seal.
Remove the dust cover from the control valve housing.
Keep
Turn
-
F40537
Vinyl Tape
(d)
F40538
(e)
(f)
Remove the 2 bolts and the control valve housing with the
control valve.
Remove the gasket.
(g)
(h)
Using a plastic hammer, remove the control valve.
Remove the oil seal from the control valve.
F40539
Vinyl Tape
F40540
F45959
(i)
Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 control valve spacers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the spacer grooves.
Control Valve Spacer
R11572
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3309
51-34
POWER STEERING
26.
SST
(a)
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
REMOVE POWER STEERING CONTROL VALVE
UPPER OIL SEAL
Using SST and a press, remove the control valve upper
bearing and the upper oil seal from the control valve housing.
SST 09950- 70010 (09951- 07150), 09950- 60010
(09951-00250)
F40911
27.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CYLINDER END STOPPER
Using a screwdriver and a hammer, turn the cylinder end
stopper clockwise until the wire end is visible through the
service hole.
Using a screwdriver and a hammer, turn the cylinder end
stopper counterclockwise, and remove the wire and the
cylinder end stopper.
Cylinder End
Stopper
Wire
C83179
28.
REMOVE POWER STEERING RACK
29.
(a)
SST
F40542
REMOVE POWER STEERING RACK BUSH
Remove the rack bush with the rack bush oil seal from the
power steering rack.
(b) Using SST, remove the rack bush oil seal from the rack
bush.
SST 09527-2101 1, 09612-24014 (09613-22011)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the rack bush.
(c) Using a screwdriver, remove the O-ring from the rack
bush.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3310
51-35
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
30.
(a)
Dial Gauge
ZX9355
INSPECT POWER STEERING RACK
Using a dial gauge, check for runout of the steering rack
and teeth wear.
Maximum runout: 0.3 mm (0.0118 in.)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the steering rack is placed holizontally.
(b) Check the rack surface for wear and damage.
If runout exceeds maximum, replace the power steering link
assy.
31.
REMOVE POWER STEERING CYLINDER TUBE OIL
SEAL
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the cylinder tube oil seal.
SST 09950- 70010 (09951- 07360), 09950- 60010
(09951-00290)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the inside surface of the rack
housing.
SST
F40544
32. REMOVE POWER PISTON OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal and the O-ring.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil seal groove.
R10955
33.
(a)
INSTALL POWER PISTON OIL SEAL
Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid and install it
to the steering rack.
(b) Expand the new oil seal with your fingers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to overly expand the oil seal.
(c) Coat the oil seal with power steering fluid.
C03629
(d)
Install the oil seal to the steering rack, and adjust with your
fingers.
N00401
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3311
51-36
POWER STEERING
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
34.
SST
Oil Seal
-
SST
F40545
INSTALL POWER STEERING CYLINDER TUBE OIL
SEAL
(a) Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
(b) Using SST and a press, install the oil seal.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00450, 09951- 00250,
09952-06010), 09950-70010 (09951-07360)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the oil seal is installed in the correct direction.
35.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
ZK8184
INSPECT TIE ROD ASSY LH
Secure the tie rod assy LH in a vise.
Install the nut to the stud bolt.
Flip the ball joint stud back and forth 5 times.
Using a torx wrench, turn the nut continuously at a rate
of 2 to 4 seconds per turn and take the torque reading on
the 5th turn.
Turning torque:
0.49 to 3.43 N⋅m (5.0 to 35.0 kgf⋅cm, 4.3 to 30.4 in.⋅lbf)
If not within the specified torque, replace the tie rod assy LH.
36. INSPECT TIE ROD ASSY RH
HINT:
Perform the same procedure as for the LH.
37.
(a)
(b)
Rack Teeth End
INSTALL POWER STEERING RACK
Apply grease to the rack teeth ends.
Affix SST to the steering rack.
SST 09631-33010
HINT:
If necessary, scrape the burrs off the rack teeth ends and burnish.
(c) Coat SST with power steering fluid.
(d) Install the steering rack to the rack housing.
(e) Remove SST.
SST
W02101
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3312
51-37
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
38.
(a)
(b)
SST
Oil Seal
F40543
INSTALL POWER STEERING RACK BUSH
Coat a new rack bush oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
Using SST and a press, install the rack bush oil seal to the
rack bush.
SST 09950- 60010 (09951- 00400), 09950- 70010
(09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the oil seal is installed in the correct direction.
(c) Coat a new O-ring with power steering fluid and install it
to the rack bush.
(d) Coat the rack bush oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
(e) Install the rack bush to the rack housing.
HINT:
Wrap vinyl tape around the end of the steering rack in order to
prevent damaging the rack bush oil seal.
Vinyl Tape
Bush
F05730
39.
(a)
Wire
(b)
(c)
INSTALL CYLINDER END STOPPER
Align the installation hole for the wire of the cylinder end
stopper with the slot of the rack housing.
Install a new wire into the cylinder end stopper.
Using a screwdriver, turn the cylinder end stopper counterclockwise by 450 50.
Cylinder
End Stopper
F40546
40.
(a)
AIR TIGHTNESS TEST
Install SST to the rack housing.
SST 09631-12071 (09633-00010)
(b) Apply a vacuum of 53 kPa (398 mmHg, 15.65 in.Hg) for
about 30 seconds.
(c) Check that there is no change in the vacuum pressure.
If there is a change in the vacuum pressure, check the installation of the oil seals.
SST
F40547
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3313
51-38
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
41.
SST
Oil Seal
SST
F40912
INSTALL POWER STEERING CONTROL VALVE
UPPER OIL SEAL
(a) Coat the control valve upper bearing with grease, and a
new control valve upper oil seal lip with power steering
fluid.
(b) Using SST and a press, install a new control valve upper
oil seal.
SST 09950- 70010 (09951- 07150), 09950- 60010
(09951-00180, 09952-06010, 09951-00320)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the oil seal is installed in the correct direction.
(c)
SST
SST
Using SST and a press, install the control valve upper
bearing.
SST 09950- 70010 (09951- 07150), 09950- 60010
(09951-00180, 09952-06010, 09951-00340)
F40913
42. INSTALL POWER STEERING CONTROL VALVE
(a) Expand 4 new valve spacers with your fingers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to overly expand the valve spacers.
(b) Coat the 4 valve spacers with power steering fluid.
(c) Install the 4 valve spacers to the control valve, and adjust
with your fingers.
C03629
(d)
Carefully slide the tapered end of SST over the valve
spacers until they fit to the control valve.
SST 09631-20081
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the valve spacers.
SST
Control Valve Spacer
R11573
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3314
51-39
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(e) Coat the oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
(f)
Install the control valve into the valve housing.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the valve spacer and oil seal lip.
HINT:
Wrap vinyl tape around the end of the steering rack in order to
prevent damaging the oil seal.
Vinyl Tape
F40548
(g)
(h)
SST
F40549
Oil Seal
F45958
Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
Using SST and a press, install the oil seal.
SST 09612-2201 1
NOTICE:
Make sure that the oil seal is installed in the correct direction.
(i)
Apply grease to the needle roller bearing of the rack housing and the serrated part of the control valve.
(j)
Install a new gasket to the valve housing.
(k)
Install the control valve housing with the control valve to
the rack housing with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Wrap vinyl tape around the lower spline of the control valve in
order to prevent damaging the oil seal.
F40539
Keep
SST
(l)
(m)
Turn
Using SST, keep the control valve from rotating and install
a new lock nut.
SST 09616-0001 1
Torque: 25 N⋅m (250 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
Apply sealant to 2 or 3 threads of the rack housing cap.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
F40550
(n)
Socket Wrench (27 mm)
Using a socket wrench (27 mm), install the rack housing
cap.
Torque: 59 N⋅m (597 kgf⋅cm, 43 ft⋅lbf)
F40536
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3315
51-40
POWER STEERING
(o)
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
Using a punch and a hammer, stake the rack housing cap
and the rack housing.
F41608
43.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
INSTALL RACK GUIDE
Apply grease to the compression spring and the contact surface of the rack guide.
Install the rack guide and the compression spring.
Apply sealant to 2 or 3 threads of the rack guide spring cap.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Temporarily install the rack guide spring cap.
44.
(a)
(b)
ADJUST TOTAL PRELOAD
Temporarily install the RH and LH rack ends sub-assy, in
order to prevent the oil seal from being damaged by the
rack teeth.
Using SST, torque the rack guide spring cap.
SST 09631-10021
Torque: 25 N⋅m (250 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
SST
F40724
(c)
Using SST, loosen the rack guide spring cap.
SST 09631-10021
(d)
Using SST, turn the control valve to right and left 1 or 2
times.
SST 09616-0001 1
Using SST, loosen the rack guide spring cap until the
compression spring stops functioning.
SST 09631-10021
SST
F40725
SST
(e)
F40726
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3316
51-41
POWER STEERING
(f)
SST
SST
(g)
F40553
(h)
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
Using SST and a torque wrench, tighten the rack guide
spring cap until the preload falls within specifications.
SST 09616-0001 1, 09631-10021
Preload (turning):
1.2 to 1.5 N⋅m (12.2 to 15.3 kgf⋅cm, 10.6 to 13.3 in.⋅lbf)
Apply sealant to 2 or 3 threads of the rack guide spring
cap lock nut.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Temporarily install the rack guide spring cap lock nut.
(i)
Rack Guide Spring
Cap Nut
SST
Fulcrum Length
SST
F40554
Using SST, hold the rack guide spring cap and using
another SST, torque the spring cap lock nut.
SST 09616-0001 1, 09922-10010
Torque: 51 N⋅m (515 kgf⋅cm, 38 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922-10010, following the direction shown in the
illustration.
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 345 mm (13.58
in.).
(j)
Precheck the total preload.
Preload (turning):
1.2 to 1.5 N⋅m (12.2 to 15.3 kgf⋅cm, 10.6 to 13.3 in.⋅lbf)
(k) Remove the RH and LH rack ends sub-assy.
(l)
Apply MP grease around the control valve shaft, as
shown in the illustration.
(m)
(n)
Wrap vinyl tape around the spline of the control valve.
Install the dust cover to the control valve housing.
MP Grease
F40555
Vinyl Tape
F40538
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3317
51-42
POWER STEERING
45.
(a)
RH:
SST
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
INSTALL STEERING RACK END SUB-ASSY
Install 2 new claw washers, and temporarily install the 2
rack ends sub-assy.
HINT:
Align the claws of the claw washer with the steering rack
grooves.
(b) Using SST, install the 2 rack end sub-assy.
SST 09922-10010
Torque: 60 N⋅m (616 kgf⋅cm, 45 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922-10010, following the direction shown in the
illustration.
HINT:
Using SST, hold the rack and install the rack end subassy.
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 345 mm
(13.58 in.).
Fulcrum Length
LH:
SST
Fulcrum
Length
F47052
(c)
Using a brass bar and a hammer, stake the 2 claw washers.
NOTICE:
Avoid any impact to the steering rack.
C35928
46.
(a)
INSPECT STEERING RACK END SUB-ASSY
Ensure that the holes of the rack ends are not clogged
with grease.
HINT:
If the hole is clogged, the pressure inside the boot will change
after it is assembled and steering wheel is turned.
ZX9390
47.
48.
F41951
INSTALL STEERING RACK BOOT NO.2
INSTALL STEERING RACK BOOT NO.1
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3318
51-43
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
49.
(a)
INSTALL STEERING RACK BOOT NO.2 CLAMP
Using SST, tighten the rack boot No.2 clamp, as shown
in the illustration.
SST 09521-24010
Clearance: 3.0 mm (0.118 in.) or less
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the boot.
SST
F40556
50.
INSTALL STEERING RACK BOOT NO.1 CLAMP
SST 09521-24010
HINT:
Perform the same procedure as for the No.2 clamp.
51. INSTALL STEERING RACK BOOT CLIP
(a) Using pliers, install the 2 boot clips.
52.
(a)
INSTALL TIE ROD ASSY LH
Screw the lock nut and tie rod assy LH on the rack end until the matchmarks are aligned.
Torque: 74 N⋅m (750 kgf⋅cm, 54 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
After adjusting toe-in, torque the lock nut (see page 26-7 ).
Matchmarks
F40050
53. INSTALL TIE ROD ASSY RH
HINT:
Perform the same procedure as for the LH.
54.
(a)
Fulcrum
Length
(b)
O-ring
INSTALL STEERING LEFT TURN PRESSURE TUBE
Coat 2 new O-rings with power steering fluid and install
them to the left turn pressure tube.
Using SST, install the left turn pressure tube to the steering link assy.
SST 09023-38201
Torque: 11 N⋅m (116 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
SST
F40557
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 300 mm
(9.84 in.).
This torque value is effective when SST is parallel to a
torque wrench.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3319
51-44
POWER STEERING
55.
(a)
(b)
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
INSTALL STEERING RIGHT TURN PRESSURE TUBE
Perform the same procedure as for the left turn pressure tube.
SST 09023-38201
Install the tube clamp to the turn pressure tubes.
LH:
RH:
56.
(a)
INSTALL POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
Install the power steering link assy with the 2 bolts and the
nuts.
Torque: 70 N⋅m (714 kgf⋅cm, 52 ft⋅lbf)
57.
(a)
CONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE ASSY
Using SST, connect the pressure feed tube assy to the
steering link assy.
SST 09023-12701
Torque: 22 N⋅m (230 kgf⋅cm, 16 ft⋅lbf)
D29979
HINT:
Fulcrum
Length
SST
D30610
(b)
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 300 mm
(11.81 in.).
This torque value is effective when SST is parallel to a
torque wrench.
Install the pressure feed tube assy clamp with the bolt.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
F40334
58.
(a)
CONNECT RETURN TUBE ASSY
Using SST, connect the return tube assy to the steering
link assy.
SST 09023-12701
Torque: 22 N⋅m (230 kgf⋅cm, 16 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Fulcrum
Length
SST
D30609
(b)
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 300 mm
(11.81 in.).
This torque value is effective when SST is parallel to a
torque wrench.
Install the tube clamp to the pressure feed tube assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3320
51-45
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
(c)
Install the return tube clamp with the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
59.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.1 LH
Install the stabilizer bar bush No.1 to the stabilizer bar.
Install the stabilizer bracket No.1 LH and the stabilizer
bracket No.2 with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 16 N⋅m (163 kgf⋅cm, 12 ft⋅lbf)
F40331
D30771
60. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BRACKET NO.1 RH
HINT:
Perform the same procedure as for the LH.
61. CONNECT FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
62. CONNECT FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSY RH
HINT:
Perform the same procedure as for the LH.
63.
Matchmarks
(a)
(b)
CONNECT STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
SUB-ASSY
Align the matchmarks on the intermediate shaft sub-assy
and the steering link assy.
Install the bolt.
Torque: 35 N⋅m (360 kgf⋅cm, 26 ft⋅lbf)
F40352
(c)
B
(d)
(e)
A
Tighten bolt A.
Torque: 35 N⋅m (360 kgf⋅cm, 26 ft⋅lbf)
Install the steering column hole cover No.2 to the steering
hole cover No.1.
Install the clamp to the steering column hole cover No.1
and tighten bolt B.
F46489
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3321
51-46
POWER STEERING
-
POWER STEERING LINK ASSY
64. CONNECT TIE ROD ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 30-21 )
65. CONNECT TIE ROD ASSY RH
HINT:
Perform the same procedure as for the LH.
66. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N⋅m (1,050 kgf⋅cm, 76 ft⋅lbf)
67. BLEED POWER STEERING FLUID (SEE PAGE 51-3 )
68. CHECK POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKAGE
69. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (SEE PAGE 26-7 )
70. PERFORM STEERING ANGLE SENSOR ZERO POINT CALIBRATION (SEE PAGE 05-765 )
71. INSPECT STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3322
55-1 1
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
REFRIGERANT
REFRIGERANT
5502F-03
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT REFRIGERANT VOLUME
Check the sight glass on the cooler refrigerant liquid pipe
A.
Test conditions:
Engine is running at 1,500 rpm
Blower speed control switch is at ”HI”
A/C switch is ON
Temperature control dial is at ”MAX. COOL”
Doors are fully open
Sight Glass
I30576
Item
Symptom
Amount of refrigerant
Corrective Actions
1
Bubbles exist
Insufficient*
(1) Check for gas leakage and repair if necessary
(2) Add refrigerant until bubbles disappear
2
No bubbles exist
Empty, insufficient or excessive
Refer to 3 and 4
3
No temperature difference between compressor inlet and outlet
Empty or nearly empty
(1) Check for gas leakage with gas leak detector and repair if necessary
(2) Add refrigerant until bubbles disappear
4
Considerable temperature difference between compressor inlet and outlet
Proper or excessive
Refer to 5 and 6
5
Immediately after air conditioning is turned
off, refrigerant clears
Excessive
(1) Discharge refrigerant
(2) Remove air and supply proper amount of
purified refrigerant
6
Immediately after air conditioning is turned
off, refrigerant foams and then becomes
clear
Proper
-
*: Bubbles in the sight glass with ambient temperatures higher than usual can be considered normal if cooling
is sufficient.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3333
55-12
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
2.
(a)
-
REFRIGERANT
INSPECT REFRIGERANT PRESSURE WITH MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
This is a method in which the trouble is located by using
a manifold gauge set. Read the manifold gauge pressure
when these conditions are established.
Test conditions:
Temperature at the air inlet with the switch set
at RECIRC is 30 to 35°C (86 to 95°F)
Engine is running at 1,500 rpm
Blower speed control switch is at ”HI”
Temperature control dial is at ”COOL”
A/C switch is ON
Doors are fully open
(1) Normally functioning refrigeration system
Gauge reading:
Low pressure side:
0.15 to 0.25 MPa (1.5 to 2.5 kgf/cm2)
High pressure side:
1.37 to 1.57 MPa (14 to 16 kgf/cm2)
E50573
(2)
Moisture is present in refrigeration system
Condition : Periodically cools and then fails to cool.
I22117
Symptom
Probable cause
During operation, pressure on low
pressure side cycles between normal and vacuum
Moisture in refrigeration system
freezes at expansion valve orifice,
causing a temporary stop of cycle.
However, when it melts, normal
state is restored.
Diagnosis
Drier in oversaturated state
Moisture in refrigeration system
freezes at expansion valve orifice
and blocks circulation of refrigerant
Corrective Actions
(1) Replace condenser
(2) Remove moisture in cycle by
repeatedly evacuating air
(3) Supply proper amount of new
refrigerant
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3334
55-13
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
(3)
REFRIGERANT
Insufficient cooling
Condition: Cooling system does not function effectively.
I22118
Symptom
Pressure is low on both low and
high pressure sides
Bubbles are seen through sight
glass continuously
Insufficient cooling performance
Probable cause
Diagnosis
Gas leakage in refrigeration system
(4)
Insufficient refrigerant
Refrigerant leaking
Corrective Actions
(1) Check for gas leakage and repair if necessary
(2) Supply proper amount of new
refrigerant
(3) If the indicated pressure value
is close to 0 when connected to
the gauge, create a vacuum after
inspecting and repairing the location of leakage.
Poor circulation of refrigerant
Condition: Cooling system does not function effectively.
I22119
Symptom
Pressure is low on both low and
high pressure sides
Frost exists on pipe from condenser to unit
Probable cause
Refrigerant flow is obstructed by
dirt in the receiver
Diagnosis
Receiver is clogged
Corrective Action
Replace condenser
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3335
55-14
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
(5)
-
REFRIGERANT
Refrigerant does not circulate
Condition: Cooling system does not function (sometimes it may function).
I22120
Symptom
Vacuum is indicated on low pressure side and very low pressure is
indicated on high pressure side
Frost or dew is seen on piping on
both sides of receiver/drier or expansion valve
Probable cause
Diagnosis
Refrigerant flow is obstructed by
moisture or dirt in refrigeration system
Refrigerant does not circulate
Refrigerant flow is obstructed by
a gas leak from expansion valve
(6)
Corrective Actions
(1) Check the expansion valve
(2) Clean out dirt in expansion
valve by blowing air
(3) Replace condenser
(4) Evaporate air and supply proper amount of new refrigerant
(5) For gas leakage from expansion valve, replace expansion
valve
Refrigerant is overcharged or cooling effectiveness
of condenser is insufficient
Condition: Cooling system does not function.
I22121
Symptom
Probable cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
Pressure is too high on both low
and high pressure sides
No air bubbles are seen through
sight glass even when engine rpm
lowers
Unable to develop sufficient performance due to excessive use of
refrigeration system
Cooling effectiveness of condenser is insufficient
Excessive refrigerant in
cycle → excessive refrigerant is
supplied
Condenser cooling effectiveness
is insufficient → condenser fins
are clogged at cooling fan
(1) Clean condenser
(2) Check cooling fan with cooling
fan motor operation
(3) If (1) and (2) are normal check
the amount of refrigerant and supply proper amount of refrigerant
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3336
55-15
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
(7)
REFRIGERANT
Air present in refrigeration system
Condition: Cooling system does not function.
NOTE: These gauge indications occur when the
refrigeration system opens
and the refrigerant is
charged without vacuum
purging.
Symptom
Pressure is too high on both low
and high pressure sides
The low pressure piping is too
hot to touch
Bubbles can be seen through
sight glass
Probable cause
Diagnosis
Air present in refrigeration system
Insufficient vacuum purging
Air in system
(8)
I22122
Corrective Actions
(1) Check compressor oil to see if
it is dirty or insufficient
(2) Evacuate air and supply new
refrigerant
Expansion valve malfunction
Condition: Insufficient cooling
I22123
Symptom
Pressure is too high on both low
and high pressure sides
Frost or large amount of dew on
piping on low pressure side
Probable cause
Trouble in expansion valve
Diagnosis
Excessive refrigerant in low
pressure piping
Expansion valve opened too
wide
Corrective Actions
Check expansion valve
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3337
55-16
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
REFRIGERANT
(9)
Defective compressor
Condition : Insufficient cooling
I22124
Symptom
Probable cause
Pressure is too high both on low
and high pressure sides
Pressure is too low on high pressure side
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
Compression failure
Leakage from damaged valve or
broken sliding parts
Internal leak in compressor
Repair or replace compressor
Gauge readings (Reference)
Pressure on low pressure side
MPa (kgf/cm2)
0.5 (5.0)
Blower HI Zone
0.4 (4.0)
1.06 (10.8)
0.3 (3.0)
0.27 (2.75)
0.2 (2.0)
1.2 (12.2)
0.22 (2.24)
0.2 (2.03)
Blower LO Zone
1.25 (12.7)
0.14 (1.42)
0.5 (5.0)
1.32 (13.4)
1.0 (10.0)
1.5 (15.0)
Pressure on high
pressure side
2.0 (20.0)
MPa (kgf/cm2)
I30081
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3338
55-17
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
REFRIGERANT
5519P-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
Turn the A/C switch on.
Operate the cooler compressor at an engine rpm of approximately 1,000 for 5 to 6 minutes to circulate
the refrigerant and collect compressor oil remaining in each component into the cooler compressor as
much as possible.
(c) Stop the engine.
(d) Using SST, let the refrigerant gas out.
SST 07110-58060 (07117-58080, 07117-58090, 07117-78050, 07117-88060, 07117-88070,
07117-88080)
2.
CHARGE REFRIGERANT
(a) Using a vacuum pump, perform vacuum purging.
(b) Using SST charge refrigerant, HFC-134a (R134a).
Standard: 650 50 g (22.93 1.76 oz.)
SST 07110-58060 (07117-58060, 07117-58070, 07117-58080, 07117-58090, 07117-78050,
07117-88060, 07117-88070, 07117-88080)
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine before charging with refrigerant as the cooler compressor doesn’t work properly without any refrigerant, which causes the compressor to overheat.
Amount to be charged
Add. 100g
Mean
value
in proper
range
50 g (1.76 oz.)
High
Pressure
Overcharged
Point where
bubbles disappear
Refrigerant Amount
Sub-cool system
I37365
3.
WARM UP ENGINE
NOTICE:
Warm up the engine at less than 2000 rpm for 2 minutes or more after charging with refrigerant.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3339
55-18
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
REFRIGERANT
4.
(a)
INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
Perform in these conditions:
Stop the engine.
Secure good ventilation (the gas leak detector may
not react to volatile gases which are not refrigerant,
such as evaporated gasoline and exhaust gas).
Repeat the test 2 or 3 times.
Make sure that there is some refrigerant remaining
in the refrigeration system.
When compressor is off: approx. 392 to 588 kPa (4
to 6 kgf/cm2, 57 to 85 psi)
(b)
Bring the gas leak detector close to the drain hose before
performing the test.
Drain Hose
HINT:
Gas Leak Detector
N14519
After the blower motor has stopped, leave the cooling unit
for more than 15 minutes.
Expose the gas leak detector sensor under the drain
hose.
When bringing the gas leak detector close to the drain
hose, make sure that the gas leak detector does not react
to the volatile gases.
If such reaction is unavoidable, the vehicle must be lifted up.
(c) If a gas leak is not detected on the drain hose, remove the
blower motor control (blower resistor) from the cooling
unit. Insert the gas leak detector sensor into the unit and
perform the test.
(d) Disconnect the connector and leave the pressure switch
for approximately 20 minutes. Bring the gas leak detector
close to the pressure switch and perform the test.
(e) Bring the gas leak detector close to the refrigerant lines
and perform the test.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3340
55-24
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT
PULLEY) BELT NO.1
5519R-01
ADJUSTMENT
1.
Bolt C
Bolt A
(a)
(b)
(c)
Bolt B
Measuring
Position
I38885
Boroughs
TO
HINT:
DENSO
ADJUST V (COOLER COMPRESSOR
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
Loosen bolt A.
Loosen bolt B.
Apply drive belt tension by turning bolt C.
Drive belt tension:
New belt: 160 to 180 lbf
Used belt: 115 to 135 lbf
”New V belt” refers to a belt which has been used for less
than 5 minutes on a running engine.
”Used V belt” refers to a belt which has been used for 5
minutes or more on a running engine.
N01881
(d)
Bolt A
(e)
Tighten bolt A.
Torque: 58 N⋅m (591 kgf⋅cm, 43 ft⋅lbf)
Tighten bolt B.
Torque: 18 N⋅m (183 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
Bolt B
I30370
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3346
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
55-21
V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT
PULLEY) BELT NO.1
V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY)
BELT NO.1
5519Q-01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
Measuring
Position
I38885
DENSO
Boroughs
N01881
Correct
INSPECT V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
Belt tension:
Using a belt tension gauge, check the V belt tension.
V belt
New belt
N (kg, lb)
Used belt
N (kg, lb)
160 to 180
115 to 135
NOTICE:
Check the V belt deflection at the specified point.
When installing a new belt, set its tension value as
specified.
When checking a belt used for over 5 minutes, confirm the deflection value is within the specified range.
When reinstalling a belt used for over 5 minutes, perform the check based on the used deflection value.
V belt tension and deflection values should be
checked after 2 revolutions of engine cranking.
When using a belt tension gauge, confirm the accuracy first by using a master gauge.
Check that the drive belt fits properly in the ribbed
grooves.
Wrong
CH0086
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3343
55-22
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT
PULLEY) BELT NO.1
5519S-01
REPLACEMENT
Bolt C
Bolt A
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE V (COOLER COMPRESSOR
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
Loosen bolt A.
Loosen bolt B.
Loosen bolt C and remove the V belt.
TO
INSTALL V (COOLER COMPRESSOR
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
Temporarily install the V belt as illustrated.
TO
Bolt B
I30370
2.
(a)
Correct
Wrong
I30370
I36012
I39353
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3344
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT
PULLEY) BELT NO.1
55-23
3.
Bolt C
Measuring
Position
I38885
Correct
-
ADJUST V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(a) Apply drive belt tension by turning bolt C.
Drive belt tension:
New belt: 160 to 180 lbf
Used belt: 115 to 135 lbf
NOTICE:
”New V belt” refers to a belt which has been used for
less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
”Used V belt” refers to a belt which has been used for
5 minutes or more on a running engine.
After installing the V belt, check that it fits properly in
the ribbed grooves.
Wrong
I36012
4.
Bolt A
(a)
(b)
Bolt B
FULLY TIGHTEN V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
Tighten bolt A.
Torque: 58 N⋅m (591 kgf⋅cm, 43 ft⋅lbf)
Tighten bolt B.
Torque: 18 N⋅m (183 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
I30370
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3345
55-25
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
INTEGRATION CONTROL & PANEL ASSY
INTEGRATION CONTROL & PANEL ASSY
5519T-01
COMPONENTS
Manual Air Conditioning:
Heater Control Name Sheet No. 2
Air Conditioning Amplifier Assy
Integration Control & Panel Bulb x5
Heater Control Housing Sub-assy
Heater Control Housing
Heater Blower Switch
Heater Control
Name Sheet
No.1
Control Knob Sub-assy
AUTO Air Conditioning:
Heater Control Housing Sub-assy
Control Knob Sub-assy
Integration Control &
Panel Bulb
I40413
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3347
55-26
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
INTEGRATION CONTROL & PANEL ASSY
5519U-01
OVERHAUL
HINT:
COMPONENTS: see page 55-25
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
2.
REMOVE INTEGRATION CONTROL & PANEL ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
3.
REMOVE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
4.
REMOVE CONTROL KNOB SUB-ASSY
5.
REMOVE HEATER CONTROL NAME SHEET NO.1 (MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING)
6.
(a)
REMOVE HEATER CONTROL NAME SHEET NO.2
Using a screwdriver protected by taping, remove the
heater control name sheet No. 2.
7.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE HEATER CONTROL HOUSING SUB-ASSY
Release the lock of connector and disconnect the cable.
Remove the 8 screws and heater control housing.
8.
(a)
REMOVE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
Remove the 3 screws and air conditioner amplifier assy
from the heater control housing.
E51992
E51993
E51994
9.
REMOVE HEATER BLOWER SWITCH (MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3348
55-27
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
5519V-01
COMPONENTS
Instrument Panel Reinforcement
29 (300, 21)
29 (300, 21)
29 (300, 21)
29 (300, 21)
29 (300, 21)
29 (300, 21)
Instrument Panel
Brace Sub-assy
No.1
29 (300, 21)
12 (122, 9)
29 (300, 21)
29 (300, 21)
Floor Shift Assy
20 (200, 14)
Heater to Register
Duct Center
Air Conditioning
Radiator Assy
29 (300, 21)
Instrument Panel Brace
Sub-assy No.2
Air Duct No.1
Water Hose
Air Duct No.2
Piping Clamp
O-ring
Blower Assy
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Bracket
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Compressor Oil ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
Non-reusable parts
I39666
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3349
55-28
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
Cooler Expansion
Valve
Cooler Evaporator
Sub-assy No.1
O-ring
O-ring
5.4 (55, 48 in.⋅lbf)
Wiring Air Conditioning
Harness Sub-assy
AUTO
AIR CONDITIONER:
Blower Resistor
Blower Motor Control
Clamp
Cooler Thermistor
No.1
Plate
Heater Radiator Unit Sub-assy
Wiring Air Conditioning
Harness Sub-assy No.2
Air Mix Damper Servo
Sub-assy
Mode Damper Servo
Sub-Assy
Air Duct No.2
Air Duct No.1
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
Non-resuable parts
I30858
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3350
55-29
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
5519W-02
OVERHAUL
HINT:
COMPONENTS: see page 55-27 ,71-6
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
SST 07110-58060 (07117-58080, 07117-58090, 07117-78050, 07117-88060, 07117-88070,
07117-88080)
2.
(a)
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT SUCTION
PIPE NO.1
Install SST on piping clamp.
SST 09870-00015
HINT:
Make sure the direction of the piping clamp claw and SST by
seeing the illustration shown on the caution label.
SST
I03838
(b) Push down the SST and release the clamp lock.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to deform the tube when pushing SST.
(c) Pull SST slightly and push the release lever, and then remove the piping clamp with SST.
Pull
Push
SST
Release
Lever
Disconnect the
tube using hand
I03839
(d) Disconnect the cooler refrigerant suction hose No.1.
NOTICE:
Do not use tools like screwdriver to remove the tube.
Cap the open fittings immediately to keep moisture or
dirt out of the system.
(e) Remove the 2 O-rings from the cooler refrigerant suction
hose No.1.
Screw
Driver
I06919
3.
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE A
SST 09870-00025
HINT:
Disconnect of the cooler refrigerant liquid pipe A is same as the cooler refrigerant suction pipe No.1.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3351
55-30
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
4.
(a)
DISCONNECT HEATER OUTLET WATER HOSE
Using pliers, grip the claws of the clip and slide the clip,
and then disconnect the heater outlet water hose.
NOTICE:
Do not apply any excessive force to the heater outlet
water hose.
Prepare a drain pan or cloth for when the cooling water leaks.
I30392
5.
(a)
6.
DISCONNECT HEATER INLET WATER HOSE
Disconnection of the heater inlet water hose is same as the heater outlet water hose.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010, 09953-05020, 09954-05021)
HINT:
Refer to the instructions for removal of the instrument panel safety pad sub-assy.
7.
(a)
SEPARATE STEERING COLUMN ASSY
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts, disconnect the steering
column assy from the instrument panel reinforcement
assy.
8.
(a)
SEPARATE FLOOR SHIFT ASSY
Remove the 2 nuts and disconnect the shift cable.
(b)
Remove the 4 nuts and disconnect transmission floor shift
assy.
I30537
I30538
I30390
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3352
55-31
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
9.
REMOVE AIR DUCT REAR NO.2
(a) Remove the side scuff plate.
(b) Take up the floor carpet.
HINT:
Take up the floor carpet so that the air duct rear No.2 can be removed.
(c) Remove the air duct rear No.2.
I30378
10. REMOVE AIR DUCT REAR NO.1
HINT:
Remove it in the same way with the air duct rear No.2.
11.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE SUB-ASSY
NO.1
Disconnect the connector clamp.
Remove the 3 bolts, 2 nuts and instrument panel brace
sub-assy No.1.
I30377
12.
(a)
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE SUB-ASSY
NO.2
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and instrument panel brace
sub-assy No.2.
I30375
13.
REMOVE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY (W/ LEXUS NAVIGATION SYSTEM)
(SEE PAGE 55-68 )
14.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ECM
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 2 nuts, and ECU.
I30545
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3353
55-32
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
15.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE MULTIPLEX NETWORK BODY ECU
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 2 nuts and multiplex network body ECU.
16.
DISCONNECT INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION
BLOCK ASSY
Remove the bolt and 2 nuts, disconnect the instrument
panel junction block assy.
I30544
(a)
I30540
17.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SKID CONTROL ECU ASSY
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 2 nuts and skid control ECU assy.
18.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
ASSY
Remove the 5 bolts, 4 nuts and instrument panel reinforcement assy.
I30546
(a)
I30539
19.
(a)
: Clamp
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONER UNIT ASSY
Disconnect the connector and clamp.
I30386
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3354
55-33
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
(b)
(c)
20.
(a)
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
Disconnect the connectors connecting the wiring air indicator harness sub-assy and vehicle harness.
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and air conditioner unit assy.
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
Remove the screw, disconnect the connected part of the
duct and take off the air duct No.2.
I30383
:3 Claws
: 3 Claws
(b)
(c)
Remove the 4 screws and bracket.
Disconnect the connection between the blower assy and
the air conditioner radiator assy and remove the air conditioning radiator assy.
21.
(a)
REMOVE AIR DUCT NO.1
Release the 3 claw fittings, remove the air duct No.1.
22.
(a)
REMOVE HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT CENTER
Release the 4 claw fittings, remove the heater to register
duct center.
23.
(a)
REMOVE MODE DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY
Remove the 3 screws and mode damper servo sub-assy.
I30380
I30385
: 4 Claws
I30381
I30389
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3355
55-34
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
24.
(a)
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
REMOVE WIRING AIR CONDITIONING HARNESS
SUB-ASSY
Remove the wiring air conditioning harness sub-assy
from the air conditioner radiator assy.
I30388
25.
(a)
REMOVE AIRMIX DAMPER SERVO SUB-ASSY
Remove the 3 screws and airmix damper servo sub-assy.
26.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE HEATER RADIATOR UNIT SUB-ASSY
Remove the screw and clamp.
Remove the heater radiator unit sub-assy from the air
conditioner radiator assy.
I30387
I30391
27.
REMOVE COOLER THERMISTOR NO.1
28.
(a)
REMOVE BLOWER MOTOR CONTROL (AUTO AIR
CONDITIONING)
Remove the 2 screws and blower motor control.
I30382
29.
(a)
30.
(a)
REMOVE BLOWER RESISTOR (MANUAL AIR CONDITIONING)
Remove the 2 screws and blower resistor.
REMOVE WIRING AIR INDICATOR HARNESS SUB-ASSY NO.2
Remove the wiring air indicator harness sub-assy No.2 from the blower motor control.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3356
55-35
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
31.
(a)
(b)
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
REMOVE COOLER EXPANSION VALVE
Using a hexagon wrench 4 mm (0.16 in.), remove the 2
hexagon bolts and cooler expansion valve.
Remove the 2 O-rings from the air conditioner tube assy.
I30379
32.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE COOLER EVAPORATOR SUB-ASSY NO.1
Remove the 11 screws and radiator case.
Remove the cooler evaporator sub-assy No.1 from the
air conditioner radiator assy.
(c)
Remove the 2 O-rings from the cooler evaporator subassy No.1.
33.
(a)
INSTALL COOLER EVAPORATOR SUB-ASSY NO.1
Sufficiently apply compressor oil to the 2 new O-rings and
fitting surface of the coder evaporator sub-assy No.1.
Compressor oil: ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
Install the 2 O-rings on the coder evaporator sub-assy
No.1.
I30541
E69079
(b)
E69079
(c)
(d)
Install the cooler evaporator No.1 to the air conditioner radiator assy.
Install the evaporator cover with the 11 screws.
I30541
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3357
55-36
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
34.
(a)
(b)
(c)
I30379
35.
(a)
(b)
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
INSTALL COOLER EXPANSION VALVE
Sufficiently apply compressor oil to the 2 new O-rings and
fitting surface of the air conditioning tube assy.
Compressor oil: ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
Install the 2 O-rings on the air conditioning tube assy.
Using a hexagon wrench 4mm (0.15 in.), install the cooler
expansion valve and 2 hexagon bolts to the cooler evaporator No.1.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONER UNIT ASSY
Install the air conditioner unit assy with the 2 bolts and 2
nuts.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the connectors connecting the wiring air indicator No.2 harness and vehicle harness.
I40415
: Clamp
(c)
Install the connector and clamp.
36.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
ASSY
Install the instrument panel reinforcement assy with the
5 bolts and 4 nuts.
Torque: 29 N⋅m (300 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
I30386
(a)
I30539
37.
(a)
INSTALL SKID CONTROL ECU ASSY
Install the skid control ECU assy with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 5.0 N⋅m (50 kgf⋅cm, 43 in.⋅lbf)
I30546
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3358
55-37
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
38.
(a)
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSY
Install the instrument panel junction block assy with the
bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 8.4 N⋅m (86 kgf⋅cm, 74 in.⋅lbf)
I30540
39.
(a)
INSTALL ECM
Install the ECM with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
40.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE SUB-ASSY
NO.2
Install the instrument panel brace sub-assy No.2 with the
2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 29 N⋅m (300 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
I30545
(a)
I30375
41.
(a)
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE SUB-ASSY
NO.1
Install the instrument panel brace sub-assy No.1 with the
3 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 29 N⋅m (300 kgf⋅cm, 21 ft⋅lbf)
I30377
42.
(a)
(2)
(3)
(1)
INSTALL FLOOR SHIFT ASSY
Install the floor shift assy with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 12 N⋅m (122 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten the nuts in numerical order shown in the illustration to install the floor shift assy.
(4)
I30390
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3359
55-38
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
(b)
Install the shift cable with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 20 N⋅m (200 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf)
43.
(a)
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN ASSY
Install the steering column assy with the 2 bolts and 2
nuts.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (210 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
I30538
I30537
44.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
45.
Wrong
Correct
(a)
(b)
Gap
(c)
I06878
HINT:
46.
(a)
(b)
(c)
47.
48.
INSTALL COOLER REFRIGERANT SUCTION PIPE
NO.1
Remove the attached vinyl tape from the pipe.
Coat a new O-ring with compressor oil and install them
to the hose.
Compressor oil: ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
Install the cooler refrigerant suction pipe No.1 and piping
clamp.
Be sure to connect the pipe securely.
After connection, check the fitting for claw of the piping
clamp.
INSTALL COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE A
Remove the attached vinyl tape from the pipe.
Coat a new O-ring with compressor oil and install it to the pipe.
Compressor oil: ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
Install the cooler refrigerant liquid pipe A and piping clamp.
ADD COOLANT
2AZ-FE: (SEE PAGE 16-6 )
3MZ-FE: (SEE PAGE 16-26 )
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS
2AZ-FE: (SEE PAGE 16-1 )
3MZ-FE: (SEE PAGE 16-20 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3360
55-39
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
49.
50.
51.
-
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR ASSY
CHARGE REFRIGERANT (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
SST 07110-58060 (07117-58060, 07117-58070, 07117-58080, 07117-58090, 07117-78050,
07117-88060, 07117-88070, 07117-88080)
Specified amount: 650 50 g (22.93 1.76 oz.)
WARM UP ENGINE
INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3361
55-40
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
BLOWER ASSY
BLOWER ASSY
5519X-01
COMPONENTS
Blower Assy
Air Duct No. 2
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Recirculation Damper
Servo Sub-assy
Air Filter Sub-assy
Air Refiner Element
Air Filter Cover Plate
Cooling Unit Motor
Sub-assy w/ fan
Cooler Cover No.1
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
I39665
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3362
55-41
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
BLOWER ASSY
5519Y-02
OVERHAUL
HINT:
COMPONENTS: see page 55-40
1.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSY(SEE PAGE 71-10 )
Claw
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE AIR DUCT NO.2
Remove the screw.
Release the 3 claw fittings and remove the air duct No.2.
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ECM
Disconnect the connectors.
Remove the 2 nuts and ECM.
I30384
I30545
4.
(a)
REMOVE CLEAN AIR FILTER SUB-ASSY
Release the 2 claw fittings and remove the air filter sub-assy.
I37367
5.
(a)
REMOVE CLEAN AIR FILTER
Remove the air refiner element from the air filter cover
plate.
6.
(a)
REMOVE BLOWER ASSY
Disconnect the connector and clamp of the cooling unit
motor w/ fan sub-assy.
Disconnect the connector of the recirculation damper servo.
Remove the 2 screws and bracket.
(b)
(c)
I30535
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3363
55-42
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
Claw
-
BLOWER ASSY
(d)
(e)
Remove the bolt, nut and 2 screws.
Disconnect the part fitted to the air conditioner radiator
assy and remove the blower assy.
7.
REMOVE RECIRCULATION DAMPER SERVO
SUB-ASSY
Remove the 3 screws and air inlet servo motor (recirculation damper servo sub-assy).
I30536
(a)
I30577
8.
(a)
REMOVE COOLING UNIT MOTOR SUB-ASSY W/FAN
Remove the 3 screws and cooling unit motor servo subassy w/ fan.
9.
(a)
INSTALL BLOWER ASSY
Aligning the part to be fitted with that of the air conditioner
radiator assy, install the blower assy.
Install the blower assy with the bolt, nut and 2 screws.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
I30376
(b)
Claw
I30536
(c)
(d)
Install the bracket with the 2 screws.
Install the connector and clamp.
I30535
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3364
55-43
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
10.
(a)
-
BLOWER ASSY
INSTALL ECM
Install the ECM with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
I30545
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3365
55-59
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
551A3-02
COMPONENTS
Radiator Upper Support
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Radiator Upper Support
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
O-ring
5.4 (55, 47 in.⋅lbf)
5.4 (55, 47 in.⋅lbf)
O-ring
Cooler Condensor Assy
Cooler Dryer
Filter
O-ring
Cap
Non-reusable parts
Compressor oil ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
I39650
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3381
55-58
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
5502P-03
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
(a) If a fin of the cooler condenser assy is dirty, clean it with water and dry it with compressor air.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fin of the condenser assy.
(b) If a fin of the condenser assy is bent, make it straight using a screwdriver or pliers.
2.
INSPECT CONDENSER FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
(a) Using a halogen leak detector, check pipe joints for gas leakage.
(b) If gas leakage is detected in a joint, check the torque of the joint.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3380
55-60
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
551A4-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: see page 55-59
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
SST 07110-58060 (07117-58080, 07117-58090, 07117-78050, 07117-88060, 07117-88070,
07117-88080)
2.
REMOVE BATTERY
3.
REMOVE RADIATOR GRILLE (SEE PAGE 76-2 )
4.
I30395
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT DISCHARGE
PIPE A
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the cooler refrigerant
discharge pipe from the condenser assy.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the cooler refrigerant discharge
pipe.
NOTICE:
Seal the opening of the disconnected parts using vinyl tape
to prevent moisture and foreign matter from entering.
5.
I30394
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE
A
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the cooler refrigerant liquid pipe A from the condenser assy.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the cooler refrigerant liquid A
pipe.
NOTICE:
Seal the opening of the disconnected parts using vinyl tape
to prevent moisture and foreign matter from entering.
6.
(a)
REMOVE COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 radiator upper supports.
(b)
Remove the 2 bolts and slide the upper part of the radiator
rearward to remove the cooler condenser assy.
I30393
I30396
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3382
55-61
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
7.
(a)
(b)
-
COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
INSTALL COOLER CONDENSER ASSY
Insert the bush on the lower side of the cooler condenser
assy into the cross member.
Install the cooler condenser assy and 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
I30397
(c)
Install the radiator upper support and 2 bolts to the upper
part of the radiator.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
I30393
8.
(a)
10.
11.
12.
INSTALL COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE A
Remove the attached vinyl tape from the pipe and connecting part of the cooler condenser assy.
(b) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to the O-ring and pipe
joint.
Compressor oil: ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
(c) Install a new O-ring to the cooler refrigerant liquid pipe A.
(d) Connect the cooler refrigerant liquid pipe A to the condenser assy with the bolt.
I30394
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 47 in.⋅lbf)
9.
INSTALL COOLER REFRIGERANT DISCHARGE PIPE
A
(a) Remove the attached vinyl tape from the tube and connecting part of the condenser assy.
(b) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to the O-ring and tube
joint.
Compressor oil: ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
(c) Install a new O-ring to the cooler refrigerant discharge
tube.
I30395
(d) Connect the cooler refrigerant liquid pipe A to the condenser assy with the bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 47 in.⋅lbf)
CHARGE REFRIGERANT (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
SST 07110-58060 (07117-58060, 07117-58070, 07117-58080, 07117-58090, 07117-78050,
07117-88060, 07117-88070, 07117-88080)
Specified amount: 650 50 g (22.93 1.76 oz.)
WARM UP ENGINE
INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3383
55-19
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
REFRIGERANT LINE
REFRIGERANT LINE
5502H-03
COMPONENTS
3MZ-FE:
Cooler Refrigerant Liquid Pipe A
Piping Clamp (Quick joint)
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Cooler Refrigerant
Suction Hose No.1
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Cooler Refrigerant
Discharge Pipe A
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
5.4 (55, 47 in.⋅lbf)
Cooler Refrigerant
Discharge Hose No.1
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
I41129
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3341
55-20
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
REFRIGERANT LINE
2AZ-FE:
Piping Clamp (Quick joint)
Cooler Refrigerant Liquid Tube Pipe A
Cooler Refrigerant
Suction Hose No.1
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Cooler Refrigerant
Discharge Pipe A
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
5.4 (55, 47 in.⋅lbf)
Cooler Refrigerant
Discharge Hose No.1
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
I41130
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3342
55-44
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
551A1-01
COMPONENTS
Magnet Clutch Assy
Cooler Compressor Assy
Snap Ring
Snap Ring
Magnet Clutch Washer
18 (184, 13)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
I31629
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3366
55-45
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
551J3-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: see page 55-44
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
2.
REMOVE V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(SEE PAGE 14-5 )
3.
REMOVE GENERATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 19-16 )
4.
E52000
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT DISCHARGE
HOSE NO.1
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the cooler refrigerant discharge hose No.1.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the cooler refrigerant discharge
hose No.1.
NOTICE:
Seal the opening of the disconnected parts using vinyl tape
to prevent moisture and foreign matter from entering.
5.
E52001
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT SUCTION
HOSE NO.1
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the cooler refrigerant
suction hose No.1.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the cooler refrigerant suction
hose No.1.
NOTICE:
Seal the opening of the disconnected parts using vinyl tape
to prevent moisture and foreign matter from entering.
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the nut.
(c)
Using a E8 torque socket wrench, remove the stud bolt.
E52002
E52003
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3367
55-46
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
(d)
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
Remove the 3 bolts and compressor and magnetic clutch.
E52004
7.
REMOVE MAGNET CLUTCH ASSY
(a) Remove the bolt and the bracket.
(b) Place the compressor and magnetic clutch in a vise.
NOTICE:
Do not get the bracket and harness caught in the vise.
I30371
(c)
SST
(d)
Using SST, hold the magnet clutch hub.
SST 95047-10400
Remove the bolt, magnet clutch hub and magnet clutch
washer.
HINT:
There is no set number of magnet clutch washers since they are
used for adjusting.
E66758
(e)
Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring and
magnet clutch rotor.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the seal cover of the bearing when removing the snap ring.
(f)
Remove the screw and disconnect the connector.
E37091
(g)
Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring and
magnet clutch stator.
I30400
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3368
55-47
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
8.
(a)
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL MAGNET CLUTCH ASSY
Fit the parts as shown in the illustration and install the
magnet clutch stator.
I30365
(b)
Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring with
the chamfered side facing up.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the seal cover of the bearing when removing the snap ring.
(c) Install the screw and connect the connector.
I32461
(d)
I31582
Using a snap ring expander, install the magnet clutch rotor and a new snap ring with the chamfered side facing up.
NOTICE:
Do not expand the snap ring by more than 30.5 mm
(1.2 in) when installing it.
Do not damage the seal cover of the bearing when removing the snap ring.
(e) Install the magnet clutch washer and magnet clutch hub.
NOTICE:
Do not change the combination of the magnet clutch washers used before disassembly.
(f)
Using SST, hold the magnet clutch hub and install the
bolt.
SST 95047-10400
Torque: 18 N⋅m (183 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that there is no foreign matter or oil on the compressor shaft, bolt, and clutch hub.
SST
E66759
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3369
55-48
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
9.
(a)
(b)
I30372
INSPECT MAGNETIC CLUTCH CLEARANCE
Set the dial gage to the magnet clutch hub.
Connect the positive battery lead to terminal 3 of the magnet clutch connector and the negative lead to the earth
wire. Turn on and off the magnet clutch and measure the
clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.35 to 0.60 mm (0.013 to 0.023 in.)
If the measured value is not within the standard range, remove
the magnet clutch hub and adjust it with magnet clutch washers.
NOTICE:
Adjustment shall be performed with 3 or less magnet
clutch washers.
(c) Remove the compressor and magnetic clutch from the
vise.
(d)
Install bracket with the bolt.
I30371
10.
(a)
INSPECT COMPRESSOR OIL
When replacing the compressor and magnetic clutch with new one, after gradually removing the refrigerant gas from the service valve, drain the following amount of oil from the new compressor and magnetic clutch before installation.
Standard:
(Oil capacity inside new cooler compressor assy: 120 + 15 cc (4.06 + 0.5 fl.oz.)) - (Remaining
oil amount in the removed cooler compressor assy) = (Oil amount to be removed when replacing)
NOTICE:
When checking the compressor oil level, observe the precautions on the cooler removal/installation.
Because compressor oil remains in the pipes of the vehicle, if a new cooler compressor assy
is installed without removing some oil inside, the oil amount becomes too much, preventing
heat exchange in the refrigerant cycle and causing refrigerant failure.
If the remaining oil in the removed cooler compressor assy is too small in volume, check for
oil leakage.
Be sure to use ND-OIL8 for compressor oil.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3370
55-49
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
11.
(a)
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN COMPRESSOR AND
MAGNETIC CLUTCH
Install the compressor and magnetic clutch with the stud
bolt, 3 bolts and nut.
E52005
12.
Bolt A
Nut
Bolt C
Bolt B
I39669
Nut
Bolt C
Bolt A
FULLY TIGHTEN COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC
CLUTCH
Temporarily tighten nut.
(a)
HINT:
Do not over tighten the bolt until the compressor no longer
moves.
(b) Push down on the rear side of the compressor and fully
tighten bolt B, bolt C, bolt A and nut in order.
(c) Connect the connector.
Push
Bolt B
I45795
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL COOLER REFRIGERANT SUCTION HOSE
NO.1
Remove the attached vinyl tape from the hose.
Sufficiently apply compressor oil to the O-ring and fit surface of the compressor and magnetic clutch.
Install a new O-ring to the cooler refrigerant suction hose
No.1.
Compressor oil: ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
I30634
(d)
Install the cooler refrigerant suction hose No.1 to the compressor and magnetic clutch with the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
E52001
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3371
55-50
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
14.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (2AZ-FE)
INSTALL COOLER REFRIGERANT DISCHARGE
HOSE NO.1
Remove the attached vinyl tape from the hose.
Sufficiently apply compressor oil to the O-ring and fit surface of the compressor and magnetic clutch.
Install a new O-ring to the cooler refrigerant discharge
hose No.1.
Compressor oil: ND-OIL 8 or equivalent
I30633
(d)
Install the cooler refrigerant discharge hose No.1 to the
compressor and magnetic clutch with the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
E52000
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
INSTALL BELT, V-RIBBED (SEE PAGE 14-5 )
INSTALL GENERATOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 19-16 )
CHARGE REFRIGERANT (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
WARM UP ENGINE (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3372
55-62
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
REAR HEATER BLOWER SWITCH
REAR HEATER BLOWER SWITCH
551A5-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
2 Claws
2 Claws
2 Clips
1.
(a)
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM COVER FRONT LH
Using a thin flat-head screwdriver with the tip taped up
with protective tape, disengage the 2 claw fittings and remove the deck side trim cover front.
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM COVER RH
Remove the bolt.
Release the 2 clip fittings and 2 claw fittings.
Remove the connector and deck side trim cover RH.
3.
(a)
REMOVE REAR HEATER BLOWER SWITCH
Remove the 2 screws and rear heater blower switch.
I38984
I38985
I40098
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3384
55-63
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
REAR HEATER ASSY
REAR HEATER ASSY
551A6-01
COMPONENTS
Foot Air Duct Rear No.5
Rear Heater Assy
Plate
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Foot Air Duct Rear
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
9.8 (100, 87 in.⋅lbf)
Rear Heater Blower Resistor
Rear Heater Blower Motor Sub-assy
Clip
Clip
Rear Heater Unit Sub-assy
Rear Heater Blower
Fan Sub-assy
4.0 (41, 35 in.⋅lbf)
Water Pipe & Hose Sub-assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
I39532
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3385
55-64
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
REAR HEATER ASSY
551A7-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
COMPONENTS: see page 55-63
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM COVER FRONT LH (SEE PAGE 55-62 )
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM COVER RH (SEE PAGE 55-62 )
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
4.
(a)
Heater Water
Inlet Hose
Water pipe
Heater Water Outlet Hose
I39530
DISCONNECT HEATER WATER OUTLET HOSE
Using pliers, grip the claws of the clip and slide the clip,
and disconnect the heater water outlet hose.
NOTICE:
When installing or removing the hoses, hold heater
water pipes to prevent deformation.
Do not apply any excessive force to the heater water
outlet hose.
Prepare a drain pan or cloth in case the cooling water
leaks.
5.
DISCONNECT HEATER WATER INLET HOSE
HINT:
Disconnect the heater water inlet hose in the same way as the
heater water outlet hose.
6.
(a)
REMOVE FOOT AIR DUCT REAR
Remove the 2 clips and foot air duct rear.
7.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE AIR DUCT REAR NO.5
Disconnect the wire harness clamp.
Remove the 2 clips and air duct rear No.5.
I38988
Clamp
I38986
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3386
55-65
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
Clamp
Clamp
-
REAR HEATER ASSY
8.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR HEATER ASSY
Disconnect the washer hose clamp.
Remove the 4 bolts and plate.
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the heater relay No.1 clamp.
Disconnect the heater blower resistor connector.
(e)
Remove the 4 bolts and rear heater assy.
I38990
I38991
I38992
9.
(a)
REMOVE WATER PIPE & HOSE SUB-ASSY
Using pliers, grip the claws of the 2 clips and slide the 2
clips, and disconnect the heater water hose.
NOTICE:
Do not apply any excessive force to the heater water hose.
I39531
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3387
55-66
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
2 Clamps
-
REAR HEATER ASSY
10.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR HEATER BLOWER RESISTOR
Disconnect the 2 clamps and connector.
Remove the 2 screws and rear heater blower resistor.
11.
(a)
REMOVE REAR HEATER UNIT SUB-ASSY
Remove the 9 screws and clamp.
(b)
Remove the rear heater unit sub-assy from the heater
case.
12.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR HEATER BLOWER FAN SUB-ASSY
Remove the nut and heater blower fan sub-assy.
Remove the washer.
13.
REMOVE REAR HEATER BLOWER MOTOR
SUB-ASSY
Disconnect the connector clamp.
Remove the 3 screws and heater blower motor sub-assy.
I38993
I38994
I38995
I38996
(a)
(b)
Clamp
I38997
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3388
55-67
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
14.
(a)
(b)
-
REAR HEATER ASSY
INSTALL REAR HEATER BLOWER FAN SUB-ASSY
Install the washer.
Install the heater blower fan sub-assy with the nut.
Torque: 4.0 N⋅m (41 kgf⋅cm, 35 in.⋅lbf)
I38996
15.
(a)
INSTALL REAR HEATER ASSY
Install the rear heater assy with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten the bolts in the numerical order shown in the illustration to install the rear heater assy.
(2)
(3)
(1)
(4)
Clamp
I38992
(b)
(c)
Install the heater blower resistor connector.
Install the heater relay No.1.
(d)
(e)
Install the waher hose.
Install the plate with the 4 bolts.
Torque:
Bolt A: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
I38991
(A)
Clamp
I38990
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3389
55-51
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
5519Z-01
COMPONENTS
Cooler Compressor Bracket
Magnet Clutch Assy
Cooler Compressor Assy
Snap Ring
Snap Ring
18 (184, 13)
Magnet Clutch Washer
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
I31774
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3373
55-52
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
551A0-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: see page 55-51
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
SST 07110-58060 (07117-58080, 07117-58090, 07117-78050, 07117-88060, 07117-88070,
07117-88080)
2.
REMOVE V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(SEE PAGE 55-22 )
3.
5.
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT SUCTION
HOSE NO.1
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the cooler refrigerant
suction hose No.1 from the compressor and magnetic
clutch.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the cooler refrigerant suction
hose No.1.
NOTICE:
Seal the opening of the disconnected parts using vinyl tape
I30579
to prevent moisture and foreign matter from entering.
4.
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT DISCHARGE
HOSE NO.1
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the cooler refrigerant discharge hose No.1 from the compressor and magnetic
clutch.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the cooler refrigerant discharge
hose No.1.
NOTICE:
Seal the opening of the disconnected parts using vinyl tape
I30578
to prevent moisture and foreign matter from entering.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER NO.1
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
Disconnect the connector and clamp.
Remove the 2 bolts, nut and the cooler compressor bracket.
I30361
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3374
55-53
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
(c)
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
Remove the 3 bolts and the compressor and magnetic
clutch.
I30362
7.
REMOVE MAGNET CLUTCH ASSY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and the bracket.
(b) Place the compressor and magnetic clutch in a vise.
NOTICE:
Do not get the bracket and harness caught in the vise.
I30363
(c)
SST
(d)
Using SST, hold the magnet clutch hub.
SST 95047-10400
Remove the bolt, magnet clutch hub and magnet clutch
washer.
HINT:
There is no set number of magnet clutch washers since they are
used for adjusting.
E66758
(e)
Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring and
magnet clutch rotor.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the seal cover of the bearing when removing the snap ring.
(f)
Remove the screw and disconnect the connector.
E37091
(g)
Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring and
magnet clutch stator.
I30400
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3375
55-54
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
8.
(a)
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
INSTALL MAGNET CLUTCH ASSY
Fit the magnet clutch stator convex to the compressor
groove as shown in the illustration and install the magnet
clutch stator.
I30365
I40641
(b)
Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring with
the chamfered side facing up.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the seal cover of the bearing when removing the snap ring.
(c) Install the screw and connect the connector.
I32461
(d)
I31582
Using a snap ring expander, install the magnet clutch rotor and a new snap ring with the chamfered side facing up.
NOTICE:
Do not expand the snap ring by more than 30.5 mm
when installing it.
Do not damage the seal cover of the bearing when removing the snap ring.
(e) Install the magnet clutch washer and magnet clutch hub.
NOTICE:
Do not change the combination of the magnet clutch washers used before disassembly.
(f)
Using SST, hold the magnet clutch hub and install the
bolt.
SST 95047-10400
Torque: 18 N⋅m (183 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that there is no foreign matter or oil on the compressor shaft, bolt, and clutch hub.
SST
E66759
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3376
55-55
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
9.
(a)
(b)
I37852
INSPECT MAGNETIC CLUTCH CLEARANCE
Set the dial gage to the magnet clutch hub.
Connect the positive battery lead to terminal 3 of the magnet clutch connector and the negative lead to the earth
wire. Turn on and off the magnet clutch and measure the
clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.35 to 0.60 mm (0.013 to 0.023 in.)
If the measured value is not within the standard range, remove
the magnet clutch hub and adjust it with magnet clutch washers.
NOTICE:
Adjustment should be performed with 3 or less magnet
clutch washers.
(c) Remove the compressor and magnetic clutch from the
vise.
(d)
Install bracket with the 2 bolts.
I30363
10.
(a)
INSPECT COMPRESSOR OIL
When replacing the compressor and magnetic clutch with a new one, after gradually removing the refrigerant gas from the service valve, drain the following amount of oil from the new compressor and
magnetic clutch before installation.
Standard:
(Oil capacity inside new compressor and magnetic clutch: 120 + 15 cc (4.0 + 0.5 fl. oz.) ) - (Remaining oil amount in the removed compressor and magnetic clutch) = (Oil amount to be removed when replacing)
NOTICE:
When checking the compressor oil level, observe the precautions on the cooler removal/installation.
When a new compressor and magnetic clutch is installed without removing the oil remaining
in the pipes (of the vehicle), the oil amount will become excessive, which prevents heat exchange in the refrigerant and causes refrigerant failure.
If the remaining oil in the removed compressor and magnetic clutch is too small in volume,
check for oil leakage.
Be sure to use ND-OIL8 or equivalent for compressor oil.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3377
55-56
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
11.
(a)
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN COMPRESSOR AND
MAGNETIC CLUTCH
Temporarily tighten the compressor and magnetic clutch
with the 3 bolts.
I30362
12.
FULLY TIGHTEN COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC
CLUTCH
(a) Fully tighten the compressor and magnetic clutch with the
3 bolts.
Torque: 25 N⋅m (250 kgf⋅cm, 18 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten the bolts in the numerical order shown in the illustration to install the compressor and magnetic clutch.
(3)
(2)
(1)
E52158
I39849
(b)
(B)
(A)
(c)
I30361
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
14.
(a)
(b)
I30578
Install the cooler compressor bracket with the 2 bolts and
nut.
Torque:
Bolt (A): 25 N⋅m (250 kgf⋅cm, 18 in.⋅lbf)
Bolt (B): 18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 in.⋅lbf)
Nut : 25 N⋅m (250 kgf⋅cm, 18 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the connector and clamp on the cooler compressor bracket.
INSTALL COOLER REFRIGERANT DISCHARGE
HOSE NO.1
Remove the attached vinyl tape from the hose.
Sufficiently apply compressor oil to the new O-ring and
fitting surface of the compressor and magnetic clutch.
Compressor oil: ND-OIL8 or equivalent
Install the O-ring to the cooler refrigerant discharge hose
No.1.
Install the cooler refrigerant discharge hose No.1 to the
compressor and magnetic clutch with the nut.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL COOLER REFRIGERANT SUCTION HOSE
NO.1
Remove the attached vinyl tape from the hose.
Sufficiently apply compressor oil to the new O-ring and
fitting surface of the compressor and magnetic clutch.
Compressor oil: ND-OIL8 or equivalent
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3378
55-57
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY (3MZ-FE)
(c)
Install the O-ring to the cooler refrigerant suction hose
No.1.
(d)
Install the cooler refrigerant suction hose No.1 to the compressor and magnetic clutch with the bolt.
Torque: 9.8 N⋅m (100 kgf⋅cm, 87 in.⋅lbf)
I30579
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
INSTALL V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(SEE PAGE 55-22 )
ADJUST V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(SEE PAGE 55-24 )
FULLY TIGHTEN V (COOLER COMPRESSOR TO CRANKSHAFT PULLEY) BELT NO.1
(SEE PAGE 55-24 )
CHARGE REFRIGERANT (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
SST 07110-58060 (07117-58060, 07117-58070, 07117-58080, 07117-58090, 07117-78050,
07117-88060, 07117-88070, 07117-88080)
Specified amount: 650 50 g (22.93 1.76 oz.)
WARM UP ENGINE (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT (SEE PAGE 55-17 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3379
55-68
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
551A8-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
2.
3.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLA Y (CRT DISPLAY) DISPLAY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ARMREST ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE AIRCONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 3 screws and air conditioner amplifier assy.
I39670
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3390
55-7
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
551AB-01
INSPECTION
Cooler Thermistor
No.1 Connector
Front View:
1.
COOLER THERMISTOR
CONDITIONER)
NO.1(MANUAL
AIR
(a)
(b)
Remove cooler thermistor No. 1.
Check resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of cooler
thermistor No. 1 at each temperature, as shown in the
chart.
Standard:
-
E12
+
E50650
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
E12-1 - E12-2
-10 °C (14°F)
8.00 to 10.00 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
-5 °C (23°F)
6.15 to 7.65 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
0°C (32°F)
4.75 to 5.85 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
5°C (41°F)
3.70 to 4.55 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
10°C (50°F)
3.00 to 3.73 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
15°C (59°F)
2.45 to 2.88 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
20°F (68°F)
1.95 to 2.30 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
25°C (77°F)
1.60 to 1.80 kΩ
E12-1 - E12-2
30°C (86°F)
1.28 to 1.47 kΩ
NOTICE:
Even slightly touching the sensor may change the resistance value. Be sure to hold the connector of the
sensor.
When measuring the sensor temperature must be the
same as the ambient temperature.
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the resistance decrease (see
the graph below).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3329
55-8
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
Resistance
(kΩ)
12.0
11.0
10.0
9.0
8.0
7.0
6.0
5.0
4.0
3.0
2.0
1.0
0.0
-20
-4
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Maximum permissible value line
Minimum permissible value line
0
32
40 (°C)
104 (°F)
20
68
Temperature
I38768
I40629
2.
HEATER
BLOWER
CONDITIONER)
(a)
Inspect blower switch continuity.
E37726
SWITCH(MANUAL
AIR
Condition / Circuit
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
-
No continuity
LO
1-8
Continuity
M1
1-6-8
Continuity
M2
1-5-8
Continuity
HI
1-4-8
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the air conditioner control assy.
(b) Inspect illumination operation.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and negative (-) lead to terminal 3 then check that the
illuminations light up.
If there is bulb not light up, replace the bulb.
E32877
3.
BLOWER RESISTOR(MANUAL AIR CONDITIONER)
(a)
Measure resistance between terminals, as shown in the
chart below.
Tester connection
Specified condition
1-2
0.642 - 0.738 Ω
1-3
0.205 - 0.235 Ω
1-4
1.572 - 1.803 Ω
If resistance is not as specified, replace the blower resistor.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3330
55-9
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
1
2
4.
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COOLING UNIT MOTOR SUB-ASSY W/FAN(MANUAL
AIR CONDITIONER)
(a)
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and negative (-) to terminal 1, then check that the motor
operation smoothly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the blower motor.
I07858
3
4
5
3
1
HEATER BLOWER MOTOR RELAY ASSY(MANUAL
AIR CONDITIONER)
(a)
Check that the continuity exists between each pair of terminals of heater blower motor relay assy, as shown in the
chart.
5
4
1
5.
2
2
Z19533
(b)
(c)
Tester connection
Specified condition
1-4
No continuity
2-4
Continuity
3-5
62.5 - 90.9 Ω
Apply battery voltage between terminals 3 and 5.
Check continuity each pair of terminals, as shown the
chart.
Tester connection
6.
Specified condition
1-2
Continuity
2-4
No continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the heater blower motor
relay.
MAGNET CLUTCH ASSY(MANUAL AIR CONDITIONER)
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal and the negative (-) lead to the body ground.
(b) Check that the magnetic clutch energized.
If operation is not as specified, replace the magnet clutch assy.
7.
COOLER COMPRESSOR ASSY(MANUAL AIR
CONDITIONER)
(a)
(b)
le-3-2
E05280
Disconnect the cooler compressor assy connector.
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of cooler
compressor assy connector.
Resistance: 165 - 205 Ω at 20 C (68 F)
If resistance is not as specified, replace the cooler compressor
assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3331
55-10
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
8.
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
MAGNET- CLUTCH
CONDITIONER)
RELAY(MANUAL
AIR
Condition
tester connection
Specified condition
constant
1-2
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3-5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the magnet-clutch relay.
I30152
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3332
55-4
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
551AC-01
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
1
3
2
4
Low pressure side
High pressure side
ON (Continuity)
INSPECT PRESSURE SWITCH NO.1.
Magnetic clutch control:
Inspect pressure switch operation.
(1) Set on the manifold gauge set.
(2) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ohmmeter to
terminal 4 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1.
(3) Check continuity between terminals when refrigerant pressure is changed, as shown in the illustration.
If operation is not as specified, replace the pressure switch.
196 kpa
3,140 kpa
2
(2.0 kgf/cm2 28 psi) (132.0 kgf/cm 455 psi)
OFF (No continuity) OFF (No continuity)
I30146
(b)
1
2
3
4
1,370 kpa
(14.0 kgf/cm2 199 psi)
ON
OFF
(Continuity)
1,770 kpa
(No continuity)
(18.0 kgf/cm2 256 psi)
Cooling fan control:
Inspect pressure switch operation.
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ohmmeter to
terminal 2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 3.
(2) Check continuity between terminals when refrigerant pressure is changed, as shown in the illustration.
If operation is not as specified, replace the pressure switch.
I30291
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3326
55-5
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
Wire Harness Side:
1
8 1
2.
11
A11
(a)
A10
9
16 12
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONER AMPLIFIER ASSY CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connectors from the A/C amplifier assy
and inspect the connector on the wire harness side, as
shown the chart.
22
I30906
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified condition
A10-11 (GND) Body Ground
W-B - Body Ground
Constant
Continuity
A11-5 (TE) A11-12 (SG-1)
LG - P
Evaporator temp.: 25C (77F)
1.5 kΩ
A10-2 (IG) Body Ground
BR - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch: ON
Battery positive voltage
A10-2 (IG) Body Ground
BR - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch: LOCK or ACC
No voltage
A10-12 (+B) Body Ground
W - Body Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
A10-13 (ACC) Body Ground
GR - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch: ACC
Battery positive voltage
A10-13 (ACC) Body Ground
GR - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch: except ACC
No voltage
If the circuit is as specified, try to replace the A/C amplifier assy with a new one. If the circuit is as specified,
inspect the circuits connected to other parts.
From Back Side:
8
1 11
(b)
1
A11
Connect the connector to A/C amplifier assy and inspect
the wire harness side connector from the back side, as
shown in the chart.
A10
16
9 22
12
I30906
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified condition
A10-4 (MR/F) Body Ground
Y - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
A10-4 (MR/F) Body Ground
Y - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch OFF
Below 1 V
A10-5 (AIR) Body Ground
B - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch ON and air flow selector at DEF position
Below 1 V
A10-5 (AIR) Body Ground
B - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch ON and air flow selector at except DEF
position
Battery positive voltage
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3327
55-6
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified condition
A10-6 (AIF) Body Ground
W - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch ON and air inlet control selector at
FRESH
10 - 14 V
A10-6 (AIF) Body Ground
W - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch ON and air inlet control selector at RECIRCULATION
Below 1 V
A10-7 (HR) Body Ground
O - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch ON and operate the blower motor
Below 1 V
A10-7 (HR) Body Ground
O - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch ON and does not operate the blower
motor
Battery positive voltage
A10-9 (MPX-)
G
Multiplex communication circuit
-
A10-15 - A10-21
V (*1)
Ignition switch ON and light control rheostat volume DARK
No voltage
A10-15 - A10-21
V (*1)
Ignition switch ON and light control rheostat volume LIGHT
Battery voltage
A11-2 (MPX+)
V (*2)
G (*3)
Multiplex communication circuit
-
A11-6 (TPO) A11-1 (SG-4)
R-B
Turn ignition switch ON and air flow selector at DEF position
0.5 - 1.5 V
A11-6 (TPO) A11-1 (SG-4)
R-B
Turn ignition switch ON and air flow selector at FACE position
4.5 - 5.5 V
A11-7 (AOD) Body Ground
G - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch ON and air flow selector at DEF position
Battery positive voltage
A11-7 (AOD) Body Ground
G - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch ON and air flow selector at except FACE
position
Below 1 V
A11-8 (AOF) Body Ground
V - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch ON and air flow selector at except FACE
position
Below 1 V
A11-8 (AOF) Body Ground
V - Body Ground
Turn ignition switch ON and air flow selector at FACE position
Battery positive voltage
A11-9 (S5-4) A11-1 (SG-4)
BR - B
Turn ignition switch ON
4.5 - 5.5 V
A11-10 (TP) A11-12 (SG-1)
SB - P
Turn ignition switch ON and set temp.: MAX. COOL position
4.5 - 5.5 V
A11-10 (TP) A11-12 (SG-1)
SB - P
Turn ignition switch ON and set temp.: MAX. WARM position
0.5 - 1.5 V
A11-1 1 (S5-1) A11-12 (SG-1)
O-P
Turn ignition switch ON
4.5 - 5.5 V
A11-13 (AMC) A11-1 (SG-4)
GR - B
Turn ignition switch ON and set temp.: MAX. COOL position
Battery positive voltage
A11-13 (AMC) A11-1 (SG-4)
GR - B
Turn ignition switch ON and set temp.: MAX. WARM position
Below 1 V
A11-14 (AMH) A11-1 (SG-4)
B-B
Turn ignition switch ON and set temp.: MAX. COOL position
Below 1 V
A11-14 (AMH) A11-1 (SG-4)
B-B
Turn ignition switch ON and set temp.: MAX. WARM position
Battery positive voltage
*1:If the circuit is as specified, try to replace the A/C amplifier assy with a new one. If the circuit is as
specified, inspect the circuits connected to other parts.
*2: w/ Navigation System.
*3: w/o Navigation System.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3328
55-2
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
551AA-01
LOCATION
Manual A/C Models:
Engine Room J/B
Magnetic Clutch Relay
ECU-B Fuse
50 A HEATER Fuse
Condenser
Pressure Switch
Compressor and Magnetic Clutch
I30305
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3324
55-3
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Manual A/C Models:
w/o Navigation System:
w/ Navigation System:
Instrument Panel J/B
15 A HEATER Fuse
RADIO No. 2 Fuse
AM1 Fuse
Multi Display Assy
Heater Control Assembly
A/C Amplifier Assy
Evaporator
Air Outlet Damper Control Servomotor
Evaporator Temperature Sensor
Expansion Valve
Recirculation Damper Servomotor
Heater Radiator
Blower Motor
Blower Motor Resistor
Air Mix Damper Control Servomotor
I41029
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3325
55-1
HEATER & AIR CONDITIONER
-
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
551A9-01
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
DO NOT HANDLE REFRIGERANT IN AN ENCLOSED
AREA OR NEAR AN OPEN FLAME
ALWAYS WEAR EYE PROTECTION
AC2810
3.
AC2811
Wrong
LO
HI
6.
Okay
LO
BE CAREFUL NOT TO GET LIQUID REFRIGERANT IN
YOUR EYES OR ON YOUR SKIN
If liquid refrigerant gets in your eyes or on your skin.
(a) Wash the area with lots of cool water.
CAUTION:
Do not rub your eyes or skin.
(b) Apply clean petroleum jelly to the skin.
(c) Go immediately to a physician or hospital for professional
treatment.
4.
NEVER HEAT CONTAINER OR EXPOSE IT TO NAKED
FLAME
5.
BE CAREFUL NOT TO DROP CONTAINER AND NOT
TO APPLY PHYSICAL SHOCKS TO IT
HI
N11084
DO NOT OPERATE COMPRESSOR WITHOUT
ENOUGH REFRIGERANT IN REFRIGERANT SYSTEM
If there is not enough refrigerant in the refrigerant system oil lubrication will be insufficient and compressor burnout may occur,
so take care to avoid this, necessary care should be taken.
7.
DO NOT OPEN HIGH PRESSURE MANIFOLD VALVE
WHILE COMPRESSOR IS OPERATING
If the high pressure valves opened, refrigerant flows in the reverse direction and could cause the charging cylinder to rupture, so open and close the only low pressure valve.
8.
BE CAREFUL NOT TO OVERCHARGE SYSTEM WITH
REFRIGERANT
If refrigerant is overcharged, it causes problems such as insufficient cooling, poor fuel economy, engine overheating etc.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3323
60-16
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
HORN BUTTON ASSY
HORN BUTTON ASSY
600KC-08
COMPONENTS
Torx Screw
8.8 (90, 78 in.⋅lbf)
Steering Wheel Assy
Steering Column Cover UPR
Spiral Cable Sub-assy
Steering Wheel Cover
Lower No. 2
50 (510, 37)
Steering Wheel Cover Lower No. 3
Torx Screw
8.8 (90, 78 in.⋅lbf)
Steering Column Cover LWR
Horn Button Assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
H44248
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3406
60-19
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
HORN BUTTON ASSY
600OB-02
DISPOSAL
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle equipped with the SRS or disposing of the horn button assy, be sure to deploy
the airbag first in accordance with the procedure described below. If any abnormality occurs with the airbag
deployment, contact the SERVICE DEPT. of TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
CAUTION:
Never dispose of a horn button assy that has an undeployed airbag.
The airbag produces an exploding sound when it is
deployed, so perform the operation outdoors and
where it will not create a nuisance to nearby residents.
SST
H40004
1.
When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS Airbag Deployment Tool). Perform the operation in a place away from electrical noise.
When deploying the airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft) away from the horn button assy.
The horn button assy becomes extremely hot when
the airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for at least
30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a horn
button assy with a deployed airbag.
Do not apply water, etc. to a horn button assy with a
deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
DISPOSE OF HORN BUTTON ASSY (WHEN
INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a)
Check the function of the SST.
SST 09082-00700
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, always use the specified SST:
SRS Airbag Deployment Tool.
SST
H40004
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3409
60-20
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(1)
Battery
-
HORN BUTTON ASSY
Connect the SST to the battery.
Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the SST to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
HINT:
Do not connect the yellow connector of the SST which is to be
connected with the supplemental restraint system.
SST
H40005
(2)
SST
H40006
Check the function of the SST.
Press the SST activation switch, and check that the
LED of the SST activation switch comes on.
CAUTION:
If the LED comes on when the activation switch is not being
pressed, SST malfunction is possible, so be sure not to use
the SST.
(3) Disconnect the SST from the battery.
(b) Precaution (see page 60-1 ).
(c) Disconnect the battery negative terminal (see page
60-1 ).
(d)
Remove the steering column cover LWR.
(1) While turning the steering wheel assy to the right
and left, remove the 3 screws and steering column
cover LWR.
H44251
SST
H44343
(e) Install the SST.
CAUTION:
Check that there is no looseness in the steering wheel assy
and horn button assy.
(1) Disconnect the airbag connector (yellow colored
one) from the spiral cable sub-assy.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(2) Connect the SST connector to the airbag connector
of the spiral cable sub-assy.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00780
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3410
60-21
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
(3)
(4)
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
H40007
SST
H40004
HORN BUTTON ASSY
Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the vehicle front side window.
Maintaining enough clearance for the SST wire harness in the front side window, close all doors and
windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire harness.
(5) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the SST to the
negative (-) terminal.
(f)
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within a
10 m (33 ft) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that no one is
near the vehicle.
The horn button assy becomes extremely hot when
the airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for at least
30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a horn
button assy with a deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a horn button assy with a
deployed airbag.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST activation switch
comes on.
2.
DISPOSE OF HORN BUTTON ASSY (WHEN NOT
INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
When disposing of the horn button assy, never use
the customer’s vehicle to deploy the airbag.
Be sure to follow the procedure detailed below when
deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a) Check the function of the SST (see step 1-(a)).
(b) Remove the horn button assy (see page 60-17 ).
CAUTION:
When removing the horn button assy, work must be
started 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned
to the ”LOCK” position and the negative (-) terminal
cable is disconnected from the battery.
When storing the horn button assy, keep the upper
surface of the airbag deployment side facing upward.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3411
60-22
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
HORN BUTTON ASSY
(c)
Wire Harness
Diameter
Stripped Wire Harness Section
H40008
Using a service-purpose wire harness for the vehicle, tie
down the horn button assy to the disc wheel.
Wire harness: Stripped wire harness section
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
CAUTION:
If the wire harness is too thin or an alternative object is
used to tie down the horn button assy, it may be snapped
by the shock when the airbag is deployed. This is highly
dangerous. Always use a wire harness for vehicle use with
an area of at least 1.25 mm2 (0.0019 in.2).
HINT:
To calculate the area of the stripped wire harness section:
Area = 3.14 x (Diameter)2 divided by 4
(1)
L
M
H44253
SST
Install the 2 bolts with washers into the 2 bolt holes
on the horn button assy.
Bolt:
L: 35.0 mm (1.378 in.)
M: 6.0 mm (0.236 in.)
Pitch: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
NOTICE:
Tighten the bolts by hand until they become difficult
to turn.
Do not tighten the bolts excessively.
(2) After connecting the SST below to each other, connect them to the horn button assy.
SST 09082-00802 (09082-10801, 09082-30801)
H44254
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3412
60-23
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
(3)
2 times or more
2 times or more
HORN BUTTON ASSY
Using 3 wire harnesses, wind wire harness at least
2 times each around the bolts installed on the left
and right sides of the horn button assy.
CAUTION:
Tightly wind the wire harness around the bolts so that
there is no slack.
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. If there is
slack in wire harness, the horn button assy may become loose due to the shock when the airbag is
deployed. This is highly dangerous.
H44255
(4)
H44256
SST
H44257
Face the upper surface of the horn button assy upward. Separately tie the left and right sides of the
horn button assy to the disc wheel through the hub
nut holes. Position the SST connector so that it
hangs downward through a hub hole in the disc
wheel.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. If there is
slack in wire harness, the horn button assy may become loose due to the shock when the airbag is
deployed. This is highly dangerous.
Always tie down the horn button assy with the pad
side facing upward. It is highly dangerous if the horn
button assy is tied down with the metal surface facing
upward as the wire harness will be cut by the shock
caused by the airbag deployment and the horn button
assy will be thrown into the air.
NOTICE:
The disc wheel will be marked by the airbag deployment,
so use an extra disc wheel.
(d) Install the SST.
CAUTION:
Place the disc wheel on level ground.
(1) Connect the SST connector.
SST 09082-00700
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some slack for the SST wire harness inside the disc
wheel.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3413
60-24
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(2)
Battery
-
HORN BUTTON ASSY
Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the
horn button assy tied down to the disc wheel.
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
H40014
(e)
Y
Y
X
Weight
H40176
Cover the horn button assy with a cardboard box or tires.
(1) Covering method using a cardboard box:
Cover the horn button assy with the cardboard box
and place the weights on the cardboard box in 4
places with at least 190 N (19 kg, 43 lb).
Size of cardboard box:
Must exceed the following dimensions:
X = 460 mm (18.11 in.)
Y = 650 mm (25.59 in.)
NOTICE:
When the dimension Y of the cardboard box exceeds
the diameter of the disc wheel with tire which the horn
button assy is tied to, X should be the following size.
X = 460 mm (18.11 in.) + width of tire
If a cardboard box which is smaller than the specified
size is used, the cardboard box will be broken by the
shock from the airbag deployment.
(2)
Inner Diameter
Width
Tires
(3 or more)
H43247
Covering method using tires:
Place at least 3 tires without disc wheels on top of
the tire with disc wheel which the horn button assy
is tied to.
Tire size: Must exceed the following dimensions
Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
Do not use tires with disc wheels.
NOTICE:
The tires may be marked by the airbag deployment,
so use an extra tire.
Do not place the SST connector under the tire because it could be damaged.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3414
60-25
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
HORN BUTTON ASSY
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. It is highly dangerous when looseness in the wire harness results in the tires
coming free due to the shock when the airbag is deployed.
H43722
(f)
Horn Button Assy
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
H43724
H40177
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the SST to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft) radius of
the disc wheel which the horn button assy is tied to.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that no one is near
the tire.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST activation switch
comes on.
(g) Dispose of the horn button assy.
CAUTION:
The horn button assy becomes extremely hot when
the airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for at least
30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a horn
button assy with a deployed airbag.
Do not apply water, etc. to a horn button assy with a
deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
(1) Remove the horn button assy from the disc wheel.
(2) Place the horn button assy in a plastic bag, tie it
tightly and dispose of it as other general parts disposal.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3415
60-17
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
HORN BUTTON ASSY
6008Y-18
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
2.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
Screw
Case
Steering Wheel
Cover Lower No. 3
Torx
Screw
Steering Wheel Cover
Lower No. 2
H44345
H44250
3.
(a)
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.3
Using a screwdriver, remove the steering wheel cover
lower No.3.
HINT:
Tape up the screwdriver tip before use.
4.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.2
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the steering wheel cover
lower No.2.
HINT:
Tape up the screwdriver tip before use.
5.
REMOVE HORN BUTTON ASSY
(a) Place the front wheels facing straight ahead.
(b) Using a torx socket wrench (T30), loosen the 2 torx
screws until the groove along the screw circumference
catches on the screw case.
(c) Pull out the horn button assy from the steering wheel assy
and support the horn button assy with one hand as shown
in the illustration.
NOTICE:
When removing the horn button assy, do not pull the airbag
wire harness.
(d) Disconnect the horn connector.
(e) Disconnect the 2 connectors from the horn button assy.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(f)
Remove the horn button assy.
6.
(a)
INSTALL HORN BUTTON ASSY
Support the horn button assy with one hand as shown in
the illustration.
(b) Connect the 2 connectors to the horn button assy.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(c) Connect the horn connector.
H44250
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3407
60-18
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
HORN BUTTON ASSY
(d)
7.
Confirm that the circumference groove of the torx screw
fits in the screw case, and place the horn button assy onto
the steering wheel assy.
(e) Using a torx socket wrench (T30), tighten the 2 torx
screws.
Torque: 8.8 N⋅m (90 kgf⋅cm, 78 in.⋅lbf)
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
8.
(a)
H44341
9.
INSPECT HORN BUTTON ASSY
With the horn button assy installed on the vehicle, perform a visual check including the following:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the horn
button assy top surface and in the grooved portion.
Make sure that the horn sounds.
(b)
HINT:
If the horn does not sound, inspect the horn system
(see page 69-2 ).
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3408
60-26
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
60091-11
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
COMPONENTS: See page 60-16 .
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.3 (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.2 (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
REMOVE HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSY (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010, 09953-05020, 09954-05021)
8.
(a)
9.
(a)
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER LWR
Remove the 3 screws and the steering column cover
LWR.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER UPR
Remove the steering column cover UPR.
H44259
10.
(a)
REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
Disconnect the connectors from the spiral cable subassy.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(b) Disengage the 3 claws and remove the spiral cable subassy.
: Claw
H44302
11.
(a)
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
If any of the following conditions occur, replace the spiral cable sub-assy with a new one.
Condition:
Scratches or cracks on the connector
Cracks, dents or chips in the spiral cable sub-assy
12. PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
(a) Check that the front wheels are facing straight ahead.
13. INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(a) Set the turn signal switch to the neutral position.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the turn signal switch is in the neutral position or the pin of the turn signal switch may
be snapped.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3416
60-27
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(b) Install the spiral cable sub-assy with the 3 claws.
NOTICE:
When replacing the spiral cable sub-assy with a new one, remove the lock pin before installing the
steering wheel assy.
(c) Connect the connectors to the spiral cable sub-assy.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
14. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER UPR
15. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER LWR
(a) Install the steering column cover LWR with the 3 screws.
16. ADJUST SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSY
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the battery negative (-) terminal is disconnected.
CAUTION:
After removing the terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before starting the operation.
(c)
Turn the spiral cable sub-assy counterclockwise slowly
by hand until it feels firm.
(d)
Rotate the spiral cable sub-assy clockwise approximately 2.5 turns to align the marks.
H44260
HINT:
The spiral cable sub-assy will rotate approximately 2.5 turns to
both the left and right from the center.
Marks
H44261
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSY (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
INSPECT STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
INSTALL HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3417
60-28
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
600KE-05
COMPONENTS
Front Passenger Airbag Assy
5.6 (57, 49 in.⋅lbf)
5.6 (57, 49 in.⋅lbf)
20 (204, 15)
Instrument Panel Finish
Panel Lower No.2
Glove Compartment Door Assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
H44262
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3418
60-31
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
600T0-01
DISPOSAL
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle equipped with the SRS or disposing of the front passenger airbag assy, be sure
to deploy the airbag first in accordance with the procedure described below. If any abnormality occurs with
the airbag deployment, contact the SERVICE DEPT. of TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
CAUTION:
Never dispose of a front passenger airbag assy that
has an undeployed airbag.
The airbag produces an exploding sound when it is
deployed, so perform the operation outdoors and
where it will not create a nuisance to nearby residents.
SST
H40004
1.
When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS Airbag Deployment Tool). Perform the operation in a place away from electrical noise.
When deploying the airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft) away from the front passenger airbag assy.
The front passenger airbag assy becomes extremely
hot when the airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for
at least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
passenger airbag assy with a deployed airbag.
Do not apply water, etc. to a front passenger airbag
assy with a deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
DISPOSE OF FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(WHEN INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a)
(b)
(c)
SST
(d)
(e)
H40004
Check the function of the SST (see step 1-(a) on page
60-19 ).
Precaution (see page 60-1 ).
Disconnect the battery negative terminal (see page
60-1 ).
Remove the glove compartment door assy (see page
71-10 ).
Remove the instrument panel finish panel lower No.2
(see page 71-10 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3421
60-32
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(f)
SST
H44267
Install the SST.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the front passenger
airbag assy.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(2) Connect the SST connector to the front passenger
airbag assy.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00780
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
(3)
(4)
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
H40007
Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the vehicle front side window.
Maintaining enough clearance for the SST wire harness in the front side window, close all doors and
windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire harness.
(5) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the SST to the
negative (-) terminal.
(g) Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within a
10 m (33 ft) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that no one is
near the vehicle.
The front passenger airbag assy becomes extremely
hot when the airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for
at least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
passenger airbag assy with a deployed airbag.
Do not apply water, etc. to a front passenger airbag
assy with a deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST activation switch
comes on.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3422
60-33
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
2.
SST
H40004
DISPOSE OF FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(WHEN NOT INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
When disposing of the front passenger airbag assy,
never use the customer’s vehicle to deploy the airbag.
Be sure to follow the procedure detailed below when
deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a) Check the function of the SST (see step 1-(a) on page
60-19 ).
(b) Remove the front passenger airbag assy (see page
60-29 ).
CAUTION:
When removing the front passenger airbag assy,
work must be started 90 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned to the ”LOCK” position and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
When storing the front passenger airbag assy, keep
the upper surface of the airbag deployment side facing upward.
(c)
Install the 2 nuts in the front passenger airbag assy.
H44328
(d)
Wire Harness
Diameter
Stripped Wire Harness Section
H40008
Using a service-purpose wire harness for the vehicle, tie
down the front passenger airbag assy to the tire.
Wire harness: Stripped wire harness section
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
CAUTION:
If the wire harness is too thin or an alternative object is
used to tie down the front passenger airbag assy, it may be
snapped by the shock when the airbag is deployed. This is
highly dangerous. Always use a wire harness for vehicle
use with an area of at least 1.25 mm2 (0.0019 in.2).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3423
60-34
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
HINT:
To calculate the area of the stripped wire harness section:
Area = 3.14 x (Diameter)2 divided by 4
Position the front passenger airbag assy inside the tire
with the airbag deployment side facing inside.
Tire size: Must exceed the following dimensions
Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. If there is
slack in wire harness, the front passenger airbag
assy may become loose due to the shock when the
airbag is deployed. This is highly dangerous.
Always tie down the front passenger airbag assy with
the airbag deployment side facing inside the tire.
NOTICE:
The tire will be marked by the airbag deployment, so use an
extra tire.
Inner
Diameter
Width
Tire
H40311
(e)
Install the SST.
Connect the SST connector to the front passenger airbag
assy.
SST 09082-00780
SST
H44269
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3424
60-35
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(f)
Tires
(5 or more)
H44270
Place the tires.
(1) Place at least 2 tires under the tire which the front
passenger airbag assy is tied to.
(2) Place at least 2 tires over the tire which the front
passenger airbag assy is tied to. The top tire should
have the disc wheel installed.
NOTICE:
Do not place the SST connector under the tire because it
could be damaged.
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. It is highly dangerous when looseness in the wire harness results in the tires
coming free due to the shock when the airbag is deployed.
H42763
(g)
Front Passenger Airbag Assy
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
H44271
Install the SST.
Connect the SST connector.
SST 09082-00700
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some slack for the SST wire harness inside the tire.
(h) Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the SST to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft) radius of
the tire which the front passenger airbag assy is tied
to.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that no one is near
the tire.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST activation switch
comes on.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3425
60-36
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
H41436
-
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
(i)
Dispose of the front passenger airbag assy.
CAUTION:
The front passenger airbag assy becomes extremely
hot when the airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for
at least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
passenger airbag assy with a deployed airbag.
Do not apply water, etc. to a front passenger airbag
assy with a deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
(1) Remove the front passenger airbag assy from the
tire.
(2) Place the front passenger airbag assy in a plastic
bag, tie it tightly and dispose of it as other general
parts disposal.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3426
60-29
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
600SZ-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
2.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
3.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
4.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER NO.2 (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
5.
DISCONNECT FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
CONNECTOR
(a) Disconnect the connector from the front passenger airbag assy.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
H44263
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
Remove the bolt and the 2 nuts.
Remove the front passenger airbag assy.
H44264
7.
8.
(a)
INSPECT FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-1 1)
INSTALL FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
Install the front passenger airbag assy with the bolt and the 2 nuts.
Torque:
Bolt: 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Nut: 5.6 N⋅m (57 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
9.
CONNECT FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
CONNECTOR
(a) Connect the connector to the front passenger airbag
assy.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
H44266
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3419
60-30
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
10.
11.
-
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3420
60-37
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
600KH-04
COMPONENTS
Curtain Shield Airbag Assy LH
14 (143, 10)
14 (143, 10)
14 (143, 10)
14 (143, 10)
14 (143, 10)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
H44273
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3427
60-40
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
600OD-02
DISPOSAL
HINT:
Disposal procedure of the RH side is the same as that for the LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
When scrapping a vehicle equipped with the SRS or disposing of the curtain shield airbag assy LH,
be sure to deploy the airbag first in accordance with the procedure described below. If any abnormality
occurs with the airbag deployment, contact the SERVICE DEPT. of TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A.,
INC.
CAUTION:
Never dispose of a curtain shield airbag assy LH that
has an undeployed airbag.
The airbag produces an exploding sound when it is
deployed, so perform the operation outdoors and
where it will not create a nuisance to nearby residents.
SST
H40004
1.
When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS Airbag Deployment Tool). Perform the operation in a place away from electrical noise.
When deploying the airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft) away from the curtain shield airbag
assy LH.
The curtain shield airbag assy LH becomes extremely
hot when the airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for
at least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a curtain shield airbag assy LH with a deployed airbag.
Do not apply water, etc. to a curtain shield airbag assy
LH with a deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
DISPOSE OF CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(WHEN INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a)
(b)
(c)
SST
(d)
Check the function of the SST (see step 1-(a) on page
60-19 ).
Precaution (see page 60-1 ).
Disconnect the battery negative terminal (see page
60-1 ).
Remove the roof headlining assy (see page 76-21 ).
H40004
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3430
60-41
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(e)
SST
SST
H44276
Install the SST.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the curtain shield
airbag assy LH.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(2) After connecting the SST below to each other, connect them to the curtain shield airbag assy LH.
SST 09082- 00700, 09082- 00802 (09082- 10801,
09082-20801)
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
(3)
(4)
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
H41078
Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the vehicle rear side window.
Maintaining enough clearance for the SST wire harness in the rear side window, close all doors and
windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire harness.
(5) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the SST to the
negative (-) terminal.
(f)
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within a
10 m (33 ft) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that no one is
near the vehicle.
The curtain shield airbag assy LH becomes extremely
hot when the airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for
at least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a curtain shield airbag assy LH with a deployed airbag.
Do not apply water, etc. to a curtain shield airbag assy
LH with a deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST activation switch
comes on.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3431
60-42
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
2.
DISPOSE OF CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(WHEN NOT INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
When disposing of the curtain shield airbag assy LH,
never use the customer’s vehicle to deploy the airbag.
Be sure to follow the procedure detailed below when
deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a) Check the function of the SST (see step 1-(a) on page
60-19 ).
SST
(b)
H40004
Remove the curtain shield airbag assy LH (see page
60-38 ).
CAUTION:
When removing the curtain shield airbag assy LH, work
must be started 90 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned to the ”LOCK” position and the negative (-) terminal
cable is disconnected from the battery.
(c)
Remove the clamp from the curtain shield airbag assy LH.
(d)
Cut off the deployment section of the curtain shield airbag
assy LH.
Clamp
H44329
H44278
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3432
60-43
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(e)
Wire Harness
Diameter
Stripped Wire Harness Section
H40008
Width
Inner
Diameter
H44279
Using a service-purpose wire harness for the vehicle, tie
down the curtain shield airbag assy LH to the tire.
Wire harness: Stripped wire harness section
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
CAUTION:
If the wire harness is too thin or an alternative object is
used to tie down the curtain shield airbag assy LH, it may
be snapped by the shock when the airbag is deployed. This
is highly dangerous. Always use a wire harness for vehicle
use with an area of at least 1.25 mm2 (0.0019 in.2).
HINT:
To calculate the area of the stripped wire harness section:
Area = 3.14 x (Diameter)2 divided by 4
Position the curtain shield airbag assy LH inside the tire
as shown in the illustration.
Tire size: Must exceed the following dimensions
Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. If there is
slack in wire harness, the curtain shield airbag assy
LH may become loose due to the shock when the airbag is deployed. This is highly dangerous.
NOTICE:
The tire will be marked by the airbag deployment, so use an
extra tire.
(f)
Install the SST.
After connecting the SST below to each other, connect
them to the curtain shield airbag assy LH.
SST 09082-00802 (09082-10801, 09082-20801)
SST
H44280
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3433
60-44
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Tires
(5 or more)
H44281
-
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(g) Place the tires.
CAUTION:
Do not place the deployment direction of the curtain shield
airbag assy LH facing toward the ground.
(1) Place at least 2 tires under the tire which the curtain
shield airbag assy LH is tied to.
(2) Place at least 2 tires over the tire which the curtain
shield airbag assy LH is tied to. The top tire should
have the disc wheel installed.
NOTICE:
Do not place the SST connector under the tire because it
could be damaged.
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. It is highly dangerous when looseness in the wire harness results in the tires
coming free due to the shock when the airbag is deployed.
H42763
(h)
Curtain Shield
Airbag Assy LH
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
H44282
Install the SST.
Connect the SST connector.
SST 09082-00700
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some slack for the SST wire harness inside the tire.
(i)
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the SST to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft) radius of
the tire which the curtain shield airbag assy LH is
tied to.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that no one is near
the tire.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST activation switch
comes on.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3434
60-45
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
H42873
-
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(j)
Dispose of the curtain shield airbag assy LH.
CAUTION:
The curtain shield airbag assy LH becomes extremely
hot when the airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for
at least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a curtain shield airbag assy LH with a deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a curtain shield airbag assy
LH with a deployed airbag.
(1) Remove the curtain shield airbag assy LH from the
tire.
(2) Place the curtain shield airbag assy LH in a plastic
bag, tie it tightly and dispose of it as other general
parts disposal.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3435
60-38
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
600OC-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
2.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
3.
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSY (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
4.
REMOVE CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
(a) Disconnect the connector from the curtain shield airbag assy LH.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(b) Remove the 3 clips.
(c) Remove the 9 bolts and the curtain shield airbag assy LH in the order shown in the illustration.
2
3
Clip
1
8
9
Clip
7
6
Clip
5
4
H44274
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3428
60-39
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
5.
6.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 60-1 1)
INSTALL CURTAIN SHIELD AIR BAG ASSY LH
Install the curtain shield airbag assy LH with the 9 bolts in the order shown in the illustration.
Install the 3 clips.
Torque: 14 N⋅m (143 kgf⋅cm, 10 ft⋅lbf)
(c) Connect the connector to the curtain shield airbag assy LH.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
8
7
Clip
1 : RH Side
2
: RH Side
2 : LH Side
1
: LH Side
9
3
4
Clip
Clip
5
6
H44274
7.
8.
9.
INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSY (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3429
60-52
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
600KO-05
COMPONENTS
17.5 (179, 13)
17.5 (179, 13)
Air Duct
Rear No.2
Air Duct
Rear No.1
Airbag Sensor
Assy Center
Floor Carpet Cover
Center RH
Floor Carpet
Cover Center LH
Instrument Cluster
Finish Panel Assy
Center
Console Box Assy
w/ Rear Seat
Entertainment:
Box Bottom Mat
Rear Console Box Lower
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
H44291
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3442
60-53
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
600OF-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
2.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
3.
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER LH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
4.
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER RH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
5.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
6.
REMOVE REAR CONSOLE BOX LOWER (W/ REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT) (SEE PAGE
71-10 )
7.
REMOVE BOX BOTTOM MAT (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
8.
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
9.
REMOVE AIR DUCT REAR NO.2 (SEE PAGE 55-29 )
10. REMOVE AIR DUCT REAR NO.1 (SEE PAGE 55-29 )
11.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
Disconnect the 3 connectors from the airbag sensor assy
center.
Remove the 3 bolts and the airbag sensor assy center.
H44292
12. INSTALL AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the battery negative (-) terminal is disconnected.
CAUTION:
After removing the terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before starting the operation.
(c) Temporarily install the airbag sensor assy center with the 3 bolts.
NOTICE:
If the airbag sensor assy center has been dropped, or there are any cracks, dents or other defects in the case, bracket or connector, replace it with a new one.
When installing the airbag sensor assy center, be careful that the SRS wiring does not interfere
with other parts and that it is not pinched between other parts.
(d) Tighten the 3 bolts to the specified torque.
Torque: 17.5 N⋅m (179 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
(e) Connect the 3 connectors to the airbag sensor assy center.
(f)
Check that there is no looseness in the installation parts of the airbag sensor assy center.
(g) Check that the water-proof sheet is properly set.
13. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
14. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3443
60-54
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
AIRBAG SENSOR FRONT LH
AIRBAG SENSOR FRONT LH
600KQ-06
COMPONENTS
RH Headlamp Assy
LH Headlamp Assy
Airbag Sensor Front LH
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Airbag Front
RH Sensor
Radiator Grille
Front Bumper Cover
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
H44293
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3444
60-55
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
AIRBAG SENSOR FRONT LH
600KR-06
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER (SEE PAGE 76-2 )
REMOVE RADIATOR GRILLE (SEE PAGE 76-2 )
REMOVE LH HEADLAMP ASSY (SEE PAGE 65-10 )
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE AIRBAG SENSOR FRONT LH
Disconnect the connector from the airbag sensor front
LH.
Remove the 2 bolts and the airbag sensor front LH.
H44294
7.
INSTALL AIRBAG SENSOR FRONT LH
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the battery negative (-) terminal is disconnected.
CAUTION:
After removing the terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before starting the operation.
(c) Install the airbag sensor front LH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
If the airbag sensor front LH has been dropped, or there are any cracks, dents or other defects
in the case, bracket or connector, replace it with a new one.
When installing the airbag sensor front LH, be careful that the SRS wiring does not interfere with
other parts and that it is not pinched between other parts.
(d) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor front LH.
(e) Check that there is no looseness in the installation parts of the airbag sensor front LH.
8.
INSTALL LH HEADLAMP ASSY (SEE PAGE 65-10 )
9.
HEADLIGHT AIM ONLY (SEE PAGE 65-14 )
10. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
11. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3445
60-1 1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
600SY-01
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to perform the initialization of the occupant classification ECU if any of the following conditions occur (see page 05-1207 ). If the initialization is not performed, the SRS may not operate properly.
The occupant classification ECU is replaced.
Accessories (seatback tray, seat cover, etc.) are installed to the vehicle.
The passenger seat is removed from the vehicle.
Both the SRS warning light and passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator light (”OFF”) come on.
The vehicle is brought to the workshop for repair due to an accident or collision.
1.
(a)
(b)
HORN BUTTON ASSY (VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN
COLLISION)
Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
With the horn button assy installed on the vehicle, perform a visual check including the following:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the horn
button assy top surface and in the grooved portion.
H44341
2.
(a)
(b)
H40187
HORN BUTTON ASSY (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS NOT DEPLOYED)
Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
With the horn button assy removed from the vehicle, perform a visual check including the following:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
horn button assy top surface and in the grooved
portion.
Cracks or other damage to the connectors.
Deformation of the steering wheel assy.
Deformation of the horn button contact plate of the
horn button assy.
HINT:
If the horn button contact plate of the horn button assy is
deformed, never repair it. Always replace the horn button
assy with a new one.
Horn Button
Contact Plate
H44238
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3401
60-12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
There should be no interference between the horn button
assy and steering wheel assy, and the clearance should
be uniform all the way around when the new horn button
assy is installed on the steering wheel assy.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation procedures of the horn button
assy, see ”Replacement” on page 60-17 , and be sure to follow the correct procedure.
H44342
3.
(a)
(b)
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY (VEHICLE NOT
INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
With the front passenger airbag assy installed on the vehicle, perform a visual check including the following:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the instrument panel around the front passenger airbag assy.
H40190
4.
(a)
(b)
H40191
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS NOT
DEPLOYED)
Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
With the front passenger airbag assy removed from the
vehicle, perform a visual check including the following:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
front passenger airbag assy.
Cracks or other damage to the connector.
Deformation or cracks on the instrument panel or
instrument panel reinforcement.
HINT:
If the instrument panel or instrument panel reinforcement
is deformed or cracked, never repair it. Always replace it
with a new one.
H44242
There should be no interference between the instrument
panel and the front passenger airbag assy.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation procedures of the front passenger airbag assy, see ”Replacement” on page
60-29 , and be sure to follow the correct procedure.
H44306
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3402
60-13
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
5.
(a)
(b)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY (VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
With the front seat airbag assy installed on the vehicle,
perform a visual check including the following:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the front
seatback assy around the front seat airbag assy.
H44244
6.
(a)
(b)
H44245
7.
(a)
(b)
FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN
COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS NOT DEPLOYED)
Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
With the front seat airbag assy removed from the vehicle,
perform a visual check including the following:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
front seat airbag assy.
Cracks or other damage to the wire harness or connector.
CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSY (VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
With the curtain shield airbag assy installed on the vehicle, perform a visual check including the following:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the front
pillar garnish and roof headlining assy around the curtain
shield airbag assy.
H44246
8.
(a)
(b)
H44247
9.
(a)
10.
(a)
CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSY (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS NOT
DEPLOYED)
Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
With the curtain shield airbag assy removed from the vehicle, perform a visual check including the following:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
curtain shield airbag assy.
Cracks or other damage to the connector.
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER (VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS NOT
DEPLOYED)
Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3403
60-14
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
11.
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY CENTER (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS
DEPLOYED)
Replace the airbag sensor assy center (see page 60-53 ).
(a)
HINT:
The airbag sensor assy center should be replaced after any of the airbags has deployed, as it has been subjected to the impact.
12. AIRBAG FRONT SENSOR (VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
13. AIRBAG FRONT SENSOR (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS NOT
DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
(b) When the front bumper of the vehicle or its periphery is damaged, check if there is any damage to the
airbag front sensor. If there are any defects as mentioned below, replace the airbag front sensor with
a new one:
Cracks, dents or chips in the case.
Cracks or other damage to the connector.
Peeling off of the label or damage to the serial number.
14. AIRBAG FRONT SENSOR (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS DEPLOYED)
(a) Replace the airbag front sensor (see page 60-55 ).
HINT:
The airbag front sensor on the impacted side should be replaced after the horn button assy or front passenger airbag assy has deployed.
15. SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY (VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
16. SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS NOT
DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
(b) When the center pillar of the vehicle or its periphery is damaged, check if there is any damage to the
side airbag sensor assy. If there are any defects as mentioned below, replace the side airbag sensor
assy with a new one:
Cracks, dents or chips in the case.
Cracks or other damage to the connector.
Peeling off of the label or damage to the serial number.
17. SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSY (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS DEPLOYED)
(a) Replace the side airbag sensor assy (see page 60-57 ).
HINT:
The side airbag sensor assy on the impacted side should be replaced after the front seat airbag assy and
curtain shield airbag assy have deployed.
18. AIRBAG SENSOR REAR (VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
19. AIRBAG SENSOR REAR (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS NOT DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
(b) When the quarter panel of the vehicle or its periphery is damaged, check if there is any damage to the
airbag sensor rear. If there are any defects as mentioned below, replace the airbag sensor rear with
a new one:
Cracks, dents or chips in the case.
Cracks or other damage to the connector.
Peeling off of the label or damage to the serial number.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3404
60-15
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
20. AIRBAG SENSOR REAR (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS DEPLOYED)
(a) Replace the airbag sensor rear (see page 60-59 ).
HINT:
The airbag sensor rear on the impacted side should be replaced after the curtain shield airbag assy has
deployed.
21. SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
22. SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
(b) Even if the airbag was not deployed, perform a visual check for damage to the seat position airbag
sensor including the following:
Cracks, dents or chips in the case.
Cracks or other damage to the connector.
23. OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU (VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
24. OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
(b) Even if the airbag was not deployed, perform a visual check for damage to the occupant classification
ECU including the following:
Cracks, dents or chips in the case.
Cracks or other damage to the connectors.
25. WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
26. WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page 05-1215 ).
(b) Check for breaks in all wires of the SRS wire harness and exposed conductors.
(c) Check to see if the SRS wire harness connectors are cracked or chipped.
HINT:
The SRS wire harness is integrated with the engine room main wire, cowl wire, front seat wire RH and floor
wire.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3405
60-1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
600SX-01
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
HIGHLANDER is equipped with SRS, which consists of a driver airbag, front passenger airbag,
side airbag and curtain shield airbag. Failure to carry out service operations in the correct sequence could cause the SRS to unexpectedly deploy during servicing, possibly leading to serious accident. Further, if a mistake is made in servicing the SRS, it is possible that the SRS may
fail to operate when required. Before performing servicing (including removal or installation of
parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read the following items carefully, then follow the
correct procedures indicated in the repair manual.
Wait at least 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK” position and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
(The SRS is equipped with a back-up power source, so that if work is started within 90 seconds
after disconnecting the negative (-) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS may be deployed.)
Do not expose the horn button assy, front passenger airbag assy, airbag sensor assy center,
airbag front sensor, front seat airbag assy, side airbag sensor assy, curtain shield airbag assy,
airbag sensor rear, seat position airbag sensor or occupant classification ECU directly to hot
air or flames.
Be sure to perform the initialization of the occupant classification ECU if any of the following
conditions occur (see page 05-1203 ). If the initialization is not performed, the SRS may not operate properly.
The occupant classification ECU is replaced.
Accessories (seatback tray or seat cover, etc.) are installed to the vehicle.
The passenger seat is removed from the vehicle.
Both the SRS warning light and passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator light (”OFF”) come
on.
The vehicle is brought to the workshop for repair due to an accident or collision.
NOTICE:
Malfunction symptoms of the SRS are difficult to confirm, so DTCs are the most important
source of information when troubleshooting. When troubleshooting the SRS, always inspect
DTCs before disconnecting the battery.
Even in the case of a minor collision when the SRS does not deploy, the horn button assy, front
passenger airbag assy, airbag sensor assy center, airbag front sensor, front seat airbag assy,
side airbag sensor assy, curtain shield airbag assy, airbag sensor rear, seat position airbag
sensor and occupant classification ECU should be inspected (see page 60-1 1).
Before repair work, remove the airbag sensor if any kind of shock is likely to occur to the airbag
sensor during the operation.
Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing the parts, replace them with new
ones.
Never disassemble or repair the horn button assy, front passenger airbag assy, airbag sensor
assy center, airbag front sensor, front seat airbag assy, side airbag sensor assy, curtain shield
airbag assy, airbag sensor rear, seat position airbag sensor or occupant classification ECU in
order to reuse it.
If the horn button assy, front passenger airbag assy, airbag sensor assy center, airbag front
sensor, front seat airbag assy, side airbag sensor assy, curtain shield airbag assy, airbag sensor rear, seat position airbag sensor or occupant classification ECU has been dropped, or if
there are any cracks, dents or other defects in the case, bracket or connector, replace it with
a new one.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3391
60-2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V minimum) for troubleshooting the electrical
circuits.
Information labels are attached to the periphery of the SRS components. Follow the instructions in the caution.
After work on the SRS is completed, perform the SRS warning light check (see page 05-1207 ).
When the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, the memory of the clock
and audio system will be canceled. So before starting work, make a record of the contents memorized in the audio memory system. When work is finished, reset the audio system as it was
before and adjust the clock. Never use a back-up power supply from outside the vehicle to
avoid erasing the memory in each memory system.
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to the precaution in the
INTRODUCTION section (see page 01-5 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3392
60-3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
1.
SRS CONNECTORS
HINT:
SRS connectors are located as shown in the following illustration.
11
Occupant
17
18
Classification ECU
12
31
Airbag Sensor
Rear (RH)
Curtain Shield Airbag
9
Assy (RH) (Squib)
10
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy (RH)
32
29
Seat Belt
7
Pretensioner (RH)
8
30
27
Airbag Front
RH Sensor
Front Seat Airbag
15
5
16
Assy (RH) (Squib)
6
25
28
Front Passenger
3
Airbag Assy (Squib)
4
Airbag Sensor
Assy Center
26
1
2
23
21
3
4
Airbag Sensor
Front LH
Horn Button
Spiral Cable
Sub-assy
Assy (Squib)
22
27
5
Front Seat Airbag
16
Assy (LH) (Squib)
6
29
Side Airbag
Sensor Assy (LH)
24
15
28
Seat Belt
7
Pretensioner (LH)
8
31
Airbag Sensor
Rear (LH)
30
Curtain Shield Airbag
9
13
Assy (LH) (Squib)
10
Seat Position
32
19
Airbag Sensor
20
14
H44236
No.
Connector Type
Application
(1)
Terminal Twin-Lock Mechanism
Connectors 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10
(2)
Activation Prevention Mechanism
Connectors 2, 4, 22, 24, 26, 28, 30, 32
(3)
Electrical Connection Check Mechanism
Connectors 1, 2
(4)
Half Connection Prevention Mechanism
Connectors 6, 8, 10, 15, 18, 21, 27, 31
(5)
Connector Lock Mechanism
Connectors 23, 25, 29
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3393
60-4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(a)
Housing
(2)
Female
Male
Z05953
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
All connectors in the SRS are colored yellow to distinguish them from other connectors, except the seat position airbag sensor connector and the occupant classification ECU connector. Some connectors have special
functions, and are specially designed for the SRS. These
connectors use durable gold-plated terminals, and are
placed in the locations shown on the previous page to ensure high reliability.
(1)
Spacer
-
Terminal twin-lock mechanism:
Each connector has a two-piece component consisting of a housing and a spacer. This design enables the terminal to be locked securely by two locking devices (the retainer and the lance) to prevent
terminals from coming out.
Activation prevention mechanism:
Each connector contains a short spring plate. When
the connector is disconnected, the short spring
plate automatically connects the positive (+) terminal and the negative (-) terminal of the squib.
When Connector is Connected
When Connector is Disconnected
Short Spring Plate
Short Spring Plate
Contacting Male Terminal
Housing
Housing
Short Spring Plate ON
Terminal
Squib
Connectors
Squib
Short Spring Plate
Closed Circuit
R10587
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3394
60-5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
(3)
Disconnection
Detection
Pin
Airbag Sensor Assy Center
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Electrical connection check mechanism:
This mechanism electrically checks that the connectors are connected correctly and completely.
The electrical connection check mechanism is designed so that the disconnection detection pin connects with the diagnosis terminals when the connector housing lock is locked.
H41646
Half Connection
Complete Connection
Terminal for Diagnosis
Terminal for
Diagnosis
Disconnection Detection Pin
H01315
(4)
Stopper
Locking Part
Locking Arm
Half connection prevention mechanism:
If the connector is not completely connected, the
connector is disconnected due to the spring operation so that no continuity exists.
Spring
Slider
Stopper
Rebounded by Slider
(Spring)
H40180
C51019
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3395
60-6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(5)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Connector lock mechanism:
Locking the connector lock button connects the
connector securely.
1.75
Lock Button
Claw
Groove
H40181
(b)
Fig.1
Power Source
Fig.2
Safing
Sensor
Squibs
When the vehicle is involved in a frontal collision in the
hatched area (Fig.1) and the shock is larger than the predetermined level, the SRS is activated automatically. The
safing sensor is designed to go on at a smaller deceleration rate than the airbag sensor. As illustrated in Fig.2,
ignition is caused when current flows to the squib, which
happens when the safing sensor and the deceleration
sensor go on simultaneously. When a deceleration force
acts on the sensors, 2 squibs in the driver airbag and front
passenger airbag ignite and generate gas. The gas discharging into the driver airbag and front passenger airbag
rapidly increases the pressure inside the bags, breaking
the horn button assy and instrument panel. The deployment of the bags then ends, and the bags deflate as the
gas is discharged through discharge holes at the bag’s
rear or side.
Deceleration
Sensor
Z14034
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3396
60-7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
2.
(a)
(b)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR HORN BUTTON ASSY AND CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSY
Release the lock button (yellow part) of the connector using a screwdriver.
Insert the screwdriver tip between the connector and the base, and then raise the connector.
(a)
Lock Button
(Yellow Part)
Lock Button
(Yellow Part)
(b)
H42906
3.
(a)
(b)
CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR HORN BUTTON ASSY AND CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG
ASSY
Connect the connector.
Push down securely on the lock button (yellow part) of the connector. (When locking, a click sound can
be heard.)
Lock Button
(Yellow Part)
H43151
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3397
60-8
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY
Place a finger on the slider.
Slide the slider to release lock.
Disconnect the connector.
Slider
Slider
Disconnection is completed
H01584
5.
(a)
CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY
Connect the connector as shown in the illustration. (When locking, make sure that the slider returns
to its original position and a click sound can be heard.)
HINT:
When connecting, the slider will slide. Be sure not to touch the slider while connecting, as it may result in
an insecure fit.
Slider
Slider
Connection is completed
H43169
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3398
60-9
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
Place a finger on the slider.
Slide the slider to release lock.
Disconnect the connector.
Slider
Slider
Disconnection is completed
H01586
7.
(a)
CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY
Connect the connector as shown in the illustration. (When locking, make sure that the slider returns
to its original position and a click sound can be heard.)
HINT:
When connecting, the slider will slide. Be sure not to touch the slider while connecting, as it may result in
an insecure fit.
Slider
Slider
Connection is completed
H43731
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3399
60-10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
8.
Outer
(a)
(b)
H02763
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR AIRBAG
FRONT SENSOR, SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR AND AIRBAG SENSOR REAR
While holding both outer flank sides, slide the outer in the
direction shown by the arrow.
When the connector lock is released, the connectors are
disconnected .
HINT:
Be sure to hold both outer flank sides. Holding the top and bottom sides will make disconnection difficult.
Connector lock is released
Disconnection is completed
H02764
9.
(a)
CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR AIRBAG FRONT SENSOR, SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR AND
AIRBAG SENSOR REAR
Connect the connector as shown in the illustration. (When locking, make sure that the outer returns
to its original position and a click sound can be heard.)
HINT:
When connecting, the outer will slide. Be sure not to hold the outer while connecting, as it may result in an
insecure fit.
Outer
Outer
Connection is completed
H02768
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3400
60-58
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
AIR BAG SENSOR REAR LH
AIR BAG SENSOR REAR LH
600KU-06
COMPONENTS
Deck Side Trim Cover LH
Airbag Sensor Rear LH
Deck Trim Side
Panel Assy LH
17.5 (179, 13)
Rope Hook
Deck Side Trim
Box LH
Rope Hook
Deck Floor Box Rear
Deck Side Trim
Box RH
Tonneau Cover Assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Rear Floor Finish Plate
H44408
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3448
60-59
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
AIR BAG SENSOR REAR LH
6009I-12
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER ASSY (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX REAR (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR FLOOR FINISH PLATE (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM BOX LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM BOX RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM COVER LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE ROPE HOOK (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
11.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE AIR BAG SENSOR REAR LH
Disconnect the connector from the airbag sensor rear LH.
Remove the 2 bolts and the airbag sensor rear LH.
H44298
12. INSTALL AIR BAG SENSOR REAR LH
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the battery negative (-) terminal is disconnected.
CAUTION:
After removing the terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before starting the operation.
(c) Install the airbag sensor rear LH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 17.5 N⋅m (179 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
If the airbag sensor rear LH has been dropped, or there are any cracks, dents or other defects
in the case, bracket or connector, replace it with a new one.
When installing the airbag sensor rear LH, be careful that the SRS wiring does not interfere with
other parts and that it is not pinched between other parts.
(d) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor rear LH.
(e) Check that there is no looseness in the installation parts of the airbag sensor rear LH.
13. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
14. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3449
60-56
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SIDE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY LH
SIDE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY LH
600T2-01
COMPONENTS
Rear Door
Weatherstrip LH
17.5 (179, 13)
Side Airbag Sensor
Assy LH
Front Door
Weatherstrip LH
17.5 (179, 13)
7.5 (75, 67 in.⋅lbf)
Rear Door Scuff Plate LH
Front Seat Outer Belt Assy LH
42 (430, 31)
Center Pillar Garnish
Lower LH
Front Door Scuff Plate LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
H44295
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3446
60-57
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SIDE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY LH
600T3-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 61-4 )
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SIDE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY LH
Disconnect the connector from the side airbag sensor
assy LH.
Remove the 3 bolts and the side airbag sensor assy LH.
H44296
10. INSTALL SIDE AIR BAG SENSOR ASSY LH
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the battery negative (-) terminal is disconnected.
CAUTION:
After removing the terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before starting the operation.
(c) Install the side airbag sensor assy LH with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 17.5 N⋅m (179 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
If the side airbag sensor assy LH has been dropped, or there are any cracks, dents or other defects in the case, bracket or connector, replace it with a new one.
When installing the side airbag sensor assy LH, be careful that the SRS wiring does not interfere
with other parts and that it is not pinched between other parts.
(d) Connect the connector to the side airbag sensor assy LH.
(e) Check that there is no looseness in the installation parts of the side airbag sensor assy LH.
11. CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
12. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3447
60-60
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
600KV-07
COMPONENTS
Slide & Vertical
Power Seat Switch Knob
Front LH Seat Assy
Power Seat:
Reclining Power Seat
Switch Knob
36.7 (374, 27)
Front Seat
Cushion Shield Assy
36.7 (374, 27)
36.7 (374, 27)
Manual Seat:
Seat Slide Position
Sensor Protector
Front Seat Cushion
Shield Inner RH
Torx Screw
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
H44299
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3450
60-61
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
600OI-05
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
2.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
3.
REMOVE FRONT LH SEAT ASSY (SEE PAGE 72-1 1 (POWER SEAT) OR
72-19 (MANUAL SEAT))
4.
REMOVE SLIDE & VERTICAL POWER SEAT SWITCH KNOB (POWER SEAT) (SEE PAGE
72-1 1)
5.
REMOVE RECLINING POWER SEAT SWITCH KNOB (POWER SEAT) (SEE PAGE 72-1 1)
6.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD ASSY (POWER SEAT) (SEE PAGE 72-1 1)
7.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD INNER RH (MANUAL SEAT) (SEE PAGE 72-19 )
8.
(a)
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SEAT SLIDE POSITION SENSOR
PROTECTOR
Remove the seat slide position sensor protector from the
seat position airbag sensor.
REMOVE SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
Disconnect the connector from the seat position airbag
sensor.
Using a torx socket wrench (T30), remove the torx
screw and the seat position airbag sensor.
Seat Slide Position
Sensor Protector
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Torx
Screw
H44300
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3451
60-62
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
10.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SEAT POSITION AIR BAG SENSOR
Check that the ignition switch is off.
Check that the battery negative (-) terminal is disconnected.
CAUTION:
After removing the terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before starting the operation.
Using a feeler gauge 1 mm (0.039 in.), install the seat
position airbag sensor.
NOTICE:
If the seat position airbag sensor has been dropped,
or there are any cracks, dents or other defects in the
1 mm
case, bracket or connector, replace the seat position
airbag sensor with a new one.
When installing the seat position airbag sensor, be
Seat Rail
careful that the SRS wiring does not interfere with
H44333
other parts and that it is not pinched between other
parts.
HINT:
Be sure to maintain a clearance between the seat position airbag sensor and the seat rail is within 0.6 mm (0.023 in.) to 2 mm
(0.079 in.).
(d) Using a torx socket wrench (T30), tighten the torx
screw to install the seat position airbag sensor.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
(e) Make sure that a clearance between the seat position airbag sensor and the seat rail is within 0.6 mm (0.023 in.)
to 2 mm (0.079 in.).
(f)
Connect the connector to the seat position airbag sensor.
(g) Check that there is no looseness in the installation parts
of the seat position airbag sensor.
INSTALL FRONT LH SEAT ASSY (SEE PAGE 72-1 1 (POWER SEAT) OR
72-19 (MANUAL SEAT))
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
11.
12.
13.
(c)
Feeler Gauge
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3452
60-46
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY LH
FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY LH
600OE-02
DISPOSAL
HINT:
Disposal procedure of the RH side is the same as that for the LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
When scrapping a vehicle equipped with the SRS or disposing of the front seat airbag assy LH, be sure
to deploy the airbag first in accordance with the procedure described below. If any abnormality occurs
with the airbag deployment, contact the SERVICE DEPT. of TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
CAUTION:
Never dispose of a front seat airbag assy LH that has
an undeployed airbag.
The airbag produces an exploding sound when it is
deployed, so perform the operation outdoors and
where it will not create a nuisance to nearby residents.
SST
H40004
1.
When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS Airbag Deployment Tool). Perform the
operation in a place away from electrical noise.
When deploying the airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft) away from the airbag assy.
The front seat airbag assy LH becomes extremely hot
when the airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for at
least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
seat airbag assy LH with a deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a front seat airbag assy LH
with a deployed airbag.
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY LH (WHEN
INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a)
(b)
(c)
SST
(d)
H40004
Check the function of the SST (see step 1- (a) on page
60-19 ).
Precaution (see page 60-1 ).
Disconnect the battery negative terminal (see page
60-1 ).
Remove the 4 bolts from the front seat assy LH (see page
72-1 1 (power seat) or 72-19 (manual seat)).
HINT:
Keep the front seat assy LH in the cabin.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3436
60-47
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY LH
(e)
SST
H44284
Install the SST.
(1) Disconnect the connector (yellow colored one) from
the front seat airbag assy LH.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to
damage the airbag wire harness.
(2) Connect the SST connector to the front seat airbag
connector.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00750
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
(3) Install the 4 bolts to the front seat assy LH.
Torque: 36.7 N⋅m (374 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
(4)
Battery
(5)
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
H40007
Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the vehicle front side window.
Maintaining enough clearance for the SST wire harness in the front side window, close all doors and
windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire harness.
(6) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the SST to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
(f)
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within a
10 m (33 ft) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that no one is
near the vehicle.
The front seat airbag assy LH becomes extremely hot
when the airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for at
least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
seat airbag assy LH with a deployed airbag.
Do not apply water, etc. to a front seat airbag assy LH
with a deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST activation switch
comes on.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3437
60-48
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY LH
2.
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY LH (WHEN
NOT INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
When disposing of the front seat airbag assy LH, never use the customer’s vehicle to deploy the airbag.
Be sure to follow the procedure detailed below when
deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a)
SST
H40004
Wire Harness
Diameter
Stripped Wire Harness Section
H40008
Check the function of the SST (see step 1- (a) on page
60-19 ).
(b) Remove the front seat airbag assy LH.
(1) Remove the front seat assy LH (see page 72-1 1
(power seat) or 72-19 (manual seat)).
(2) Remove the 2 nuts and the front seat airbag assy
LH from the seatback assy.
CAUTION:
When removing the front seat airbag assy LH, work
must be started 90 seconds after the ignition switch
is turned to the ”LOCK” position and the negative (-)
terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
When storing the front seat airbag assy LH, keep the
upper surface of the airbag deployment side facing
upward.
(c) Using a service-purpose wire harness for the vehicle, tie
down the front seat airbag assy LH.
Wire harness: Stripped wire harness section
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
HINT:
To calculate the area of the stripped wire harness section:
Area = 3.14 x (Diameter)2 divided by 4
CAUTION:
If the wire harness is too thin or an alternative object is
used to tie down the front seat airbag assy LH, it may be
snapped by the shock when the airbag is deployed. This is
highly dangerous. Always use a wire harness for vehicle
use with an area of at least 1.25 mm2 (0.0019 in.2).
(1)
Install the 2 nuts in the front seat airbag assy LH.
H44285
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3438
60-49
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
(2)
FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY LH
Wind the wire harness around the stud bolts of the
front seat airbag assy LH as shown in the illustration.
H44286
(3)
Width
Inner
Diameter
H44287
Position the front seat airbag assy LH inside the tire
with the airbag deployment direction facing inside.
Tire size: Must exceed the following dimensions
Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. If there is
slack in wire harness, the front seat airbag assy LH
may become loose due to the shock when the airbag
is deployed. This is highly dangerous.
Always tie down the front seat airbag assy LH with the
airbag deployment direction facing inside the tire.
NOTICE:
The tire will be marked by the airbag deployment, so use an
extra tire.
(d) Install the SST.
(1) Connect the SST connector to the front seat airbag
assy LH connector.
SST 09082-00750
SST
H44288
(e)
Tires
(5 or more)
H42898
Place the tires.
(1) Place at least 2 tires under the tire which the front
seat airbag assy LH is tied to.
(2) Place at least 2 tires over the tire which the front
seat airbag assy LH is tied to. The top tire should
have the disc wheel installed.
NOTICE:
Do not place the SST connector under the tire because it
could be damaged.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3439
60-50
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY LH
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. It is highly dangerous when looseness in the wire harness results in the tires
coming free due to the shock when the airbag is deployed.
H42763
(f)
Front Seat
Airbag Assy LH
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
H01337
Install the SST.
Connect the SST connector.
SST 09082-00700
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some slack for the SST wire harness inside the tire.
(g) Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive (+) terminal and the black clip of the SST to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft) radius of
the tire which the front seat airbag assy LH is tied to.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that no one is near
the tire.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST activation switch
comes on.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3440
60-51
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
H00544
-
FRONT SEAT AIRBAG ASSY LH
(h) Dispose of the front seat airbag assy LH.
CAUTION:
The front seat airbag assy LH becomes extremely hot
when the airbag is deployed, so do not touch it for at
least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
seat airbag assy LH with a deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a front seat airbag assy LH
with a deployed airbag.
(1) Remove the front seat airbag assy LH from the tire.
(2) Place the front seat airbag assy LH in a plastic bag,
tie it tightly and dispose of it as other general parts
disposal.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3441
60-63
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
600KX-06
COMPONENTS
Front RH Seat Assy
36.7 (374, 27)
36.7 (374, 27)
Occupant Classification ECU
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
H44301
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3453
60-64
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
-
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
600T1-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
2.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
3.
REMOVE FRONT RH SEAT ASSY (SEE PAGE 72-1 1 (POWER SEAT) OR
72-19 (MANUAL SEAT))
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
Disconnect the 2 connectors from the occupant classification ECU.
Using a screwdriver, remove the occupant classification
ECU.
H44303
5.
INSTALL OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Check that the ignition switch is off.
(b) Check that the battery negative (-) terminal is disconnected.
CAUTION:
After removing the terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds before starting the operation.
(c) Install the occupant classification ECU.
(d) Connect the 2 connectors to the occupant classification ECU.
NOTICE:
If the occupant classification ECU has been dropped, or there are cracks, dents or other defects
in the case, bracket or connector, replace it with a new one.
When installing the occupant classification ECU, be careful that the SRS wiring does not interfere with other parts and that it is not pinched between other parts.
6.
INSTALL FRONT RH SEAT ASSY (SEE PAGE 72-1 1 (POWER SEAT) OR
72-19 (MANUAL SEAT))
7.
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
8.
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3454
61-3
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
FRONT SEAT BELT
610JU-01
COMPONENTS
Front Door Opening Trim Weatherstrip RH
Rear Door Opening trim Weatherstrip RH
42 (428, 31)
Shoulder Anchor Cover
Rear Door Scuff Plate RH
42 (428, 31)
Center Pillar Garnish Lower RH
7.5 (77, 66 in. ⋅lbf)
42 (428, 31)
Front Door Scuff Plate RH
Floor Anchor Cover
Manual Seat Type
Power Seat Type
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy RH
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy RH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
B77526
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3457
61-8
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
610JW-01
DISPOSAL
HINT:
When scrapping vehicles equipped with a seat belt pretensioner or disposing of a front seat outer belt (with
seat belt pretensioner), always first activate the seat belt pretensioner in accordance with the procedures
described below. If any abnormality occurs during activation of the seat belt pretensioner, contact the SERVICE DEPARTMENT of TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC. When disposing of a front seat outer belt
assy (with seat belt pretensioner) that was activated in a collision, start with step 1-(f) in this section.
SST
B50515
CAUTION:
Never dispose of a front seat outer belt assy that has
an inactivated pretensioner.
The seat belt pretensioner produces a loud, exploding sound when it activates. Perform the operation
where it will not be a nuisance to nearby residents.
When activating a front seat outer belt (with seat belt
pretensioner), stand at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the
front seat outer belt.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
seat belt with an activated pretensioner.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
activation.
Do not apply water to a front seat outer belt that has
an activated pretensioner
When activating the seat belt pretensioner, always
use the specified SST (SRS airbag deployment tool).
Perform operation in a place away from electrical interference.
SST 09082-00700
1.
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
(WHEN INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
HINT:
Prepare a battery to power activation of the seat belt pretensioner.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3462
61-9
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
(a) Check if SST is functioning.
CAUTION:
When activating the seat belt pretensioner, always use the
specified SST.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00770
SST
B50515
(1)
Connect SST red clip to the battery’s positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the negative (-) terminal.
HINT:
Do not connect the yellow connector. The yellow connector is
used to connect to the seat belt pretensioner.
Battery
SST
B50511
(2)
SST
B50514
Press SST activation switch and check that the LED
of SST activation switch turn on.
CAUTION:
If the LED turns on when the activation switch is not being
pressed, SST may be malfunctioning. Do not use SST.
(b) Disconnect SST from the battery.
(c) Disconnect the pretensioner connector.
(1) Disconnect the battery’s negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check the SRS airbag system (see page 60-53 ).
(3) Remove the front door scuff plate RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(4) Remove the rear door scuff plate RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(5) Remove the front door opening trim weatherstrip
RH (see page 76-21 ).
(6) Remove the rear door opening trim weatherstrip RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(7) Remove the center pillar garnish lower RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(8) Remove the center pillar garnish upper RH
(see page 76-21 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3463
61-10
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
(9)
(d)
Disconnect the pretensioner connector, as shown
in the illustration.
Connect SST.
(1) Install the floor anchor of the seat belt.
B61489
B60414
(2)
SST
Connect 2 SSTs, then connect the yellow connector
to the seat belt pretensioner.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00770
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging SST connector and wire harness, do
not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
SST
B51763
(3)
(4)
10 m or more
B50513
Move SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the front
of the vehicle.
Close all the doors and windows of the vehicle.
HINT:
Do not close the windows fully. Leave a gap for inserting SST
wire harness.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage SST wire harness.
(5) Connect SST red clip to the battery’s positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the negative (-) terminal.
(e) Activate the seat belt pretensioner.
(1) Confirm that no one is inside the vehicle or within 10
m (33 ft) of the vehicle.
(2) Press SST activation switch and activate the seat
belt pretensioner.
HINT:
The seat belt pretensioner operates simultaneously with the
LED light for SST activation switch.
(f)
Dispose of the outer belt (with the seat belt pretensioner).
CAUTION:
Do not touch the outer belt for at least 30 minutes after
the seat belt pretensioner has been activated. It is
very hot.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling an outer belt with a pretensioner that has been activated.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water to a front seat outer belt that has
an activated pretensioner
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3464
61-1 1
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle, activate the seat belt pretensioner,
and then scrap the vehicle with the activated outer belt
installed.
2.
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
(WHEN NOT INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
When disposing of the front seat outer belt (with the
seat belt pretensioner) only, never use the customer’s vehicle to activate the seat belt pretensioner.
Be sure to follow the procedures listed below when
activating the seat belt pretensioner.
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to activate the seat belt
pretensioner.
(a)
Cut Here
B79201
Remove the outer belt (see page 61-4 ).
(1) Wind the seat belt with the retractor.
(2) When the seat belt is sufficiently wound, cut the
seat belt approximately 10 cm from the retractor, as
shown in the illustration
HINT:
The seat belt is designed so that winding the seat belt as much
as possible before pretensioner activation will decrease the
pulling power of the seat belt during pretensioner activation.
(b) Check if SST is functioning (see step 1-(a)).
CAUTION:
When activating the seat belt pretensioner, always use the
specified SST.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00770
Battery
SST
B50511
(c)
SST
Connect SST.
(1) Connect SST, then connect them to the seat belt
pretensioner.
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging SST connector and wire harness, do
not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
SST
B51763
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3465
61-12
SEAT BELT
(2)
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
Place the outer belt on the ground and cover it with
a tire with a wheel attached.
NOTICE:
Set up the front seat outer belt assy as shown in the illustration.
SST
SST
B69491
(3)
10 m or More
B50541
Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the
wheel.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire harness.
(d) Activate the seat belt pretensioner.
(1) Connect SST red clip to the battery’s positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the battery’s negative (-)
terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within 10 m (33 ft) of the wheel.
(3) Press SST activation switch and activate the seat
belt pretensioner.
HINT:
The seat belt pretensioner operates simultaneously with the
LED light for SST activation switch.
(e) Dispose of the outer belt (with the seat belt pretensioner).
CAUTION:
Do not touch the outer belt for at least 30 minutes after
the seat belt pretensioner has been activated. It is
very hot.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling an outer belt assy with a pretensioner that has been activated.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
operation.
Do not apply water to an outer belt assy that has an
activated pretensioner.
(1) Remove the wheel and SST.
(2)
Place the outer belt in a plastic bag, tie the end tightly and dispose of it in the same way as other general
parts.
B60422
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3466
61-4
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
610JV-03
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the RH side.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
Manual seat type:
REMOVE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY RH
CAUTION:
Removal of the seat belt pretensioner must be started
at least 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned
OFF and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
Carefully read the notices for the ”pretensioner” in
the SRS airbag system section and the front seat outer belt section (see page 60-1 ).
(a) Remove the front seat RH (see page 72-1 1).
(b) Remove the front seat cushion shield inner RH
(see page 72-1 1).
(c) Remove the front seat inner belt RH.
(1) Disconnect the connector and clamp.
(2) Remove the nut and belt.
(d)
Protruding Part
B78495
Install the front seat inner belt RH.
(1) Install the belt with the nut.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not allow the anchor part of the front belt and the protruding part of the floor panel to overlap.
(e) Connect the clamp and connector.
(f)
Connect the battery’s negative battery terminal.
(g) Initialize the occupant classification sensor
(see page 72-1 1 or 72-19 ).
(h) Check the SRS warning lamp (see page 60-1 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3458
61-5
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
2.
Power seat type:
REMOVE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY RH
CAUTION:
Removal of the seat belt pretensioner must be started
at least 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned
OFF and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
Carefully read the notices for the ”pretensioner” in
the SRS airbag system section and the front seat outer belt section (see page 60-1 ).
(a) Remove the front seat assy RH (see page 72-1 1).
(b) Remove the power seat switch knobs
(see page 72-1 1).
(c) Disconnect the connector and clamp.
(d) Remove the nut and belt.
(e)
Protruding Part
B77530
Install the belt with the nut.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not allow the anchor part of the front belt and the protruding part of the floor panel to overlap.
(f)
Connect the clamp and connector.
(g) Connect the battery’s negative battery terminal.
(h) Initialize the occupant classification sensor
(see page 72-1 1 or 72-19 ).
(i)
Check the SRS warning lamp (see page 60-1 ).
3.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
CAUTION:
Removal of the seat belt pretensioner must be started
at least 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned
OFF and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
Carefully read the notices for the ”pretensioner” in
the SRS airbag system section and the front seat outer belt section (see page 60-1 ).
(a) Remove the front door scuff plate RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(b) Remove the rear door scuff plate RH (see page 76-21 ).
(c) Remove the front door opening trim weatherstrip
(see page 76-21 ).
(d) Remove the rear door opening trim weatherstrip
(see page 76-21 ).
(e) Remove the center pillar garnish lower RH
(see page 76-21 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3459
61-6
SEAT BELT
(f)
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
Remove the front seat outer belt assy RH.
(1) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove the shoulder belt anchor cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(2) Remove the bolt and shoulder anchor.
Claw
Protective
Tape
B78496
(3)
Claw
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove the floor belt anchor cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B77537
(4)
(5)
B61489
B60414
Unlock
(g)
45
Lock
B60413
Disconnect the pretensioner connector, as shown
in the illustration.
Remove the 2 bolts and outer belt.
B61488
Install the front seat outer belt assy RH.
(1) Check the amount of inclination required to lock the
retractor.
When the inclination of the retractor is 15 or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from
the retractor. When the inclination of the retractor is over 45, check that the belt locks.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
If operation is not as specified, replace the outer belt assy.
(2) Install the front seat outer belt assy RH.
Torque:
7.5 N⋅m (77 kgf⋅cm, 66 in.⋅lbf) for upper bolt
42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf) for lower bolt
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3460
61-7
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
(3)
(h)
(i)
B78597
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
(n)
(o)
(p)
Connect the pretensioner connector, as shown in
the illustration.
(4) Install the shoulder belt anchor to the shoulder belt
anchor adjuster with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
Install the center pillar garnish lower.
Install the floor anchor to the front seat with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
Install the front door scuff plate.
Install the rear door scuff plate.
Install the front door opening trim weatherstrip.
Install the rear door opening trim weatherstrip.
Connect the battery’s negative battery terminal.
Initialize the occupant classification sensor
(see page 72-1 1 or 72-19 ).
Check the SRS warning lamp (see page 60-1 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3461
61-13
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
610JX-01
COMPONENTS
7.5 (77, 66 in. ⋅lbf)
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Inner Belt Assy LH
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
Rear No. 1 Seat Outer Belt Assy RH
Rear Seat Inner Belt Assy RH
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Inner Belt Assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
B78506
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3467
61-14
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
Rear Door Opening Trim Weatherstrip RH
Quarter Pillar Garnish RH
Tonneau Cover
Back Door Weather Strip
Deck Trim Side Panel RH
Deck Board No. 2
Rope Hook
Rear Floor Finish
Plate
Deck Board Cover
Rear Door Scuff Plate RH
Deck Board No. 3
Deck Side Trim Box RH
Deck Floor Box RR
Deck Floor Box FR
Deck Side Trim Box LH
w/ Rear No. 2 Seat
Deck Trim
Foot Air Duct
Deck Board
Rear Seat Reclining Cover RH
Rear Door Scuff Plate RH
Rear Floor Silencer
Floor Carpet
B78297
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3468
61-15
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
610JY-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the RH side.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSY RH
w/o Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the deck board (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear No.1 seat RH (see page 72-35 or 72-54 ).
Remove the rear seat belt assy inner RH.
(1) Remove the bolt and belt.
Install the rear seat belt assy inner RH.
(1) Install the belt with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
REMOVE REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY CENTER
w/o Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the deck board (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear No. 1 seat RH (see page 72-35 or 72-54 ).
Remove the rear seatback cover (see page 72-35 or 72-54 ).
Remove the rear seat outer belt assy center.
(1) Remove the nut, bolt and belt.
(e)
Unlock
45
Lock
B77535
Install the rear seat outer belt assy center.
(1) Check the degree of tilt when the belt begins to lock
the ELR.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
When the inclination of the retractor is 15 or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from
the retractor. When the inclination of the inclination of the retractor is over 45 check that
the belt locks.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt assy.
(2) Install the seat belt with bolt and nut.
Torque:
7.5 N⋅m (77 kgf⋅cm, 66 in.⋅lbf) for bolt
42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf) for nut
(3) Install the seatback cover
(see page 72-35 or 72-54 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3469
61-16
SEAT BELT
Protruding Part
B76375
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
(4) Install the floor anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not allow the anchor part of the rear belt and the protruding parts of the seat cushion frame to overlap.
With the belt installed, check that the belt
locks when it is pulled out quickly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat belt assy.
(5) Check the ELR lock.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the assembly
installed.
With the belt installed, check that the belt
locks when it is pulled out quickly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt assy.
3.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSY
w/o Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the deck board (see page 76-21 ).
(b) Remove the rear No. 1 seat LH
(see page 72-35 or 72-54 ).
(c) Remove the rear seat inner belt assy.
(1) Remove the bolt and belt.
(d) Install the rear seat inner belt assy.
(1) Install the belt with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not allow the anchor part of the rear belt and the protruding parts of the floor panel to overlap.
Protruding Part
Protruding Part
B77533
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSY LH
w/o Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the deck board (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear No.1 seat LH
(see page 72-35 or 72-54 ).
Remove the rear seat inner belt assy LH.
(1) Remove the bolt and belt.
Install the rear seat inner belt assy LH.
(1) Install the belt with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3470
61-17
SEAT BELT
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
(n)
(o)
(p)
(q)
(r)
(s)
(t)
(u)
(v)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
REMOVE REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
Remove the tonneau cover (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck board cover (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck board cover No. 2 (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck board cover No. 3 (see page 76-21 ).
w/ Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the rear seat reclining cover RH
(see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck floor box RR (see page 76-21 ).
w/o Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the deck floor box FR (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear floor finish plate (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck side trim box LH (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck side trim box RH (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear No. 1 seat LH (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear No. 1 seat RH (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear door scuff plate RH
(see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear door opening trim weatherstrip RH
(see page 76-21 ).
Remove the back door weatherstrip (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rope hook (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck trim side panel RH
(see page 76-21 ).
w/ Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the quarter pillar garnish RH
(see page 76-21 ).
w/ Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the 3 clips and turn over the front floor carpet.
w/ Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the 2 clips and rear floor silencer LH and RH.
w/ Rear A/C:
Remove the 4 clips and foot air duct rear.
Remove the rear seat outer belt assy RH.
(1) Remove the bolt and shoulder anchor.
(2) Remove the bolt and belt.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3471
61-18
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
(w)
Unlock
45
Lock
B77535
Install the rear seat outer belt assy RH.
(1) Check the degree of tilt when the belt begins to lock
the ELR.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
When the inclination of the retractor is 15 or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from
the retractor. When the inclination of the inclination of the retractor is over 45 check that
the belt locks.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt assy.
(2)
Claw
Claw
Install the belt assy with the bolt, as shown in the illustration.
B78498
Protruding Part
Front Side
Floor Anchor
B78499
(3) Install the rear outer belt with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not allow the anchor part of the rear belt and the protruding parts of the floor panel to overlap.
With the belt installed, check that the belt
locks when it is pulled out quickly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat belt assy.
(4) Check the ELR lock.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer belt assy
installed.
With the belt installed, check that the belt
locks when it is pulled out quickly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3472
61-19
SEAT BELT
-
(5)
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
Check the fastening function of the child restraint
system.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer belt assy
installed.
When the belt is pulled out fully, the belt
should automatically try to retract.
After the belt has fully retracted, the belt
should be able to be pulled out and retracted
again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3473
61-20
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT BELT
REAR NO.2 SEAT BELT
610JZ-01
COMPONENTS
42 (428, 31)
Rear No. 2 Seat Outer Belt Assy RH
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
7.5 (77, 66 in. ⋅lbf)
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Lap Type Belt Assy RH
Rear Seat Inner Belt Assy
Rear Seat Lap Type Belt Assy LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
B77529
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3474
61-21
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT BELT
Rear Door Opening Trim Weatherstrip RH
Deck Trim Side Cover
Deck Trim Side Panel RH
Rear Seat Reclining Cover RH
Rear Door Scuff Plate RH
Tonneau Cover
Back Door Weatherstrip
Deck Board No. 2
Deck Board Cover
Rear Floor Finish Plate
Deck Board No. 3
Rear Floor Box RR
Rear Floor Trim Box RH
Deck Floor Box FR
Deck Side Trim Box LH
B78296
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3475
61-22
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT BELT
610K0-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
2.
(a)
(b)
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the RH side.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
REMOVE REAR SEAT LAP TYPE BELT RH
Remove the rear No. 2 seat (see page 72-61 ).
Remove the rear seat lap type belt assy RH.
(1) Remove the bolt and belt.
Install the rear seat lap type belt assy RH.
(1) Remove the bolt and belt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSY
Remove the rear No. 2 seat (see page 72-61 ).
Remove the rear seat inner belt assy.
(1) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 belts.
(c)
Protruding Part
B77531
Install the rear seat inner belt assy.
(1) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 belts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not allow the anchor part of the rear belt and the protruding parts of the floor panel to overlap.
3.
REMOVE REAR NO.2 SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
(a) Remove the tonneau cover (see page 76-21 ).
(b) Remove the deck board cover (see page 76-21 ).
(c) Remove the deck board cover No. 2 (see page 76-21 ).
(d) Remove the deck board cover No. 3 (see page 76-21 ).
(e) Remove the rear seat reclining cover LH
(see page 76-21 ).
(f)
Remove the rear seat reclining cover RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(g) Remove the deck floor box RR (see page 76-21 ).
(h) Remove the rear floor finish plate (see page 76-21 ).
(i)
Remove the deck side trim box LH (see page 76-21 ).
(j)
Remove the deck side trim box RH (see page 76-21 ).
(k) Remove the rear No. 1 seat LH (see page 76-21 ).
(l)
Remove the rear No. 1 seat RH (see page 76-21 ).
(m) Remove the rear No. 2 seat RH (see page 76-21 ).
(n) Remove the rear door opening trim weatherstrip RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(o) Remove the back door weatherstrip (see page 76-21 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3476
61-23
SEAT BELT
(p)
(q)
(r)
(s)
Seat Belt Anchor Cover
(t)
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT BELT
Remove the rope hook (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear door scuff plate RH
(see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck trim side panel RH
(see page 76-21 ).
Remove the quarter pillar garnish RH
(see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear No. 2 seat belt assy outer RH.
(1) Using a screwdriver, open the seat belt anchor cover
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(2) Remove the bolt and shoulder anchor.
(3) Remove the 2 bolts and belt.
Protective
Tape
Claw
B77538
(u)
Unlock
45
Lock
B77534
Install the rear No. 2 seat belt assy outer RH.
(1) Check the amount of inclination required to lock the
retractor.
When the inclination of the retractor is 15 or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from
the retractor. When the inclination of the retractor is over 45, check that the belt locks.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
If operation is not as specified, replace the outer belt assy.
(2) Install the belt with the 2 bolts.
Torque:
7.5 N⋅m (77 kgf⋅cm, 66 in.⋅lbf) for upper bolt
42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf) for lower bolt
(3) Install the shoulder anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3477
61-1
SEAT BELT
-
SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
610JS-01
LOCATION
Passenger Seat
Occupant Classification Sensor Rear
Occupant Classification Sensor Front
A/C Control Assy
Passenger Side Seat Belt Warning Lamp
Combination Meter Assy
Driver Side Seat Belt Warning Lamp
Occupant Classification ECU
Instrument Panel J/B
AM1 M-fuse
IG1 Fuse
RAD NO. 2 Fuse
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy RH
Airbag Sensor Assy
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy LH
B79063
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3455
61-2
SEAT BELT
-
SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
610JT-01
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspected Area
See Page
Driver side seat belt warning lamp does not flash
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
IG1 fuse
AM1 M-fuse
RAD NO. 2 fuse
Combination meter
Front seat inner belt assy LH
Airbag sensor assy
Wire harness
61-1
61-1
61-1
05-1898
05-1228
05-1228
Passenger side seat belt warning lamp does not flash
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
IG1 fuse
AM1 M-fuse
RAD NO. 2 fuse
A/C control assy
Front seat inner belt assy RH
Occupant classification sensor
Occupant classification ECU
Wire harness
61-1
61-1
61-1
05-1228
05-1228
05-1228
05-1228
NOTICE:
The front seat inner belt RH and LH cannot be inspected. When the front seat inner belt seems to be
malfunctioning, use the hand-held tester to check for DTCs.
HINT:
The seat belt warning system is part of the large-scale multiplex communication system. This system features shared communication wiring that reduces the wiring complexity of the communication lines. The first
step in any repair is to confirm the proper operation of the communication system. Proceed with troubleshooting after the communication has been verified (see multiplex communication system).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3456
65-14
LIGHTING
-
LH HEADLAMP ASSY
6512D-01
ADJUSTMENT
1.
(a)
VEHICLE PREPARATION FOR HEADLAMP AIM ADJUSTMENT
Prepare the vehicle:
Ensure there is no damage or deformation to the body around the headlamps.
Fill the fuel tank.
Make sure that the oil is filled to the specified level.
Make sure that the coolant is filled to the specified level.
Inflate the tires to the appropriate pressure.
Place the spare tire, tools, and jack in their original position.
Unload the trunk.
Sit a person of average weight (68 kg, 150 lbs) in the driver’s seat.
2.
PREPARATION FOR HEADLAMP AIMING (Using a
screen)
(a) Prepare the vehicle according to the following conditions:
Place the vehicle in a location that is dark enough
to clearly observe the cutoff line. The cutoff line is
a distinct line, below which light from the headlamps
can be observed and above which it cannot.
Place the vehicle at a 90 angle to the wall.
Create a 7.62 m (25 ft) distance between the vehicle
and the wall.
Place the vehicle on a level surface.
Bounce the vehicle up and down to settle the suspension.
NOTICE:
A distance of 7.62 m (25 ft) between the vehicle and the wall
is necessary for proper aim adjustment. If unavailable, secure a distance of exactly 3 m (9.84 ft) for check and adjustment. (The target zone will change with the distance so follow the instructions in the illustration.)
(b) Prepare a piece of thick white paper (approximately 2 m
(height) x 4 m (width)) to use as a screen.
(c) Draw a vertical line down the center of screen (V line).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3491
65-15
LIGHTING
-
LH HEADLAMP ASSY
(d) Set the screen as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Stand the screen perpendicular to the ground.
Align the V line on the screen with the center of the vehicle.
Aligning distance is 7.62 m (25 ft):
Aligning distance is 3 m (9.84 ft):
V RH Line
V RH Line
90
90
V Line
V Line
7.62 m (25 ft)
3 m (9.84 ft)
V LH Line
V LH Line
H Line
H Line
90
7.62 m (25 ft)
90
3 m (9.84 ft)
I41220
(e)
V LH Line
V Line
V RH Line
Draw base lines (H line, V LH, V RH lines) on the screen
as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
H Line
Ground
I33423
The base lines differ for ”low- beam inspection” and
”high-beam inspection”.
Follow the same procedures for ”high-beam inspection”.
Mark the headlamp bulb center marks on the screen. If
the center mark cannot be observed on the headlamp,
use the center of the headlamp bulb or the manufacturer’s name marked on the headlamp as the center mark.
(1) H Line (Headlamp height):
Draw a horizontal line across the screen so that it
passes through the center marks. The H line should
be at the same height as the headlamp bulb center
marks of the low-beam headlamps.
(2) V LH Line, V RH Line (Center mark position of lefthand (LH) and right-hand (RH) headlamps):
Draw two vertical lines so that they intersect the H
Line at each center mark (aligned with the center of
the low-beam headlamp bulbs).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3492
65-16
LIGHTING
-
LH HEADLAMP ASSY
3.
(a)
HEADLAMP AIMING INSPECTION
Cover or disconnect the connector of the headlamp on the opposite side to prevent light from the headlamp not being inspected from affecting headlamp aiming inspection.
NOTICE:
Do not keep the headlamp covered for more than 3 minutes. The headlamp lens is made of synthetic
resin, and may easily melt or be damaged due to heat.
HINT:
When checking the aim of the high-beam, cover the low-beam or disconnect the connector.
(b) Start the engine.
NOTICE:
Engine rpm must be 1,500 or more.
(c)
Turn on the headlamp and make sure that the cutoff line falls within the specified area, as shown in
the illustration.
HINT:
Since the low-beam light and the high-beam light are a unit, if the aim on one is correct, the other should
also be correct. However, check both beams just to make sure.
Aligning distance is 7.62 m (25 ft):
Low Beam:
101 mm
(3.97 in.)
H Line
Aligning distance is 3 m (9.84 ft):
V LH Line
V RH Line
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
53 mm
(2.08 in.)
H Line
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
101 mm
(3.97 in.)
101 mm
(3.97 in.)
High Beam:
High Beam:
101 mm
(3.97 in.)
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
H Line
H Line
101 mm
(3.97 in.)
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
101 mm
(3.97 in.)
21 mm
(0.82 in.)
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
101 mm
(3.97 in.)
V LH Line
V RH Line
V LH Line
V RH Line
Low Beam:
101 mm
(3.97 in.)
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
V LH Line
V RH Line
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
I41213
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3493
65-17
LIGHTING
-
LH HEADLAMP ASSY
4.
(a)
Aiming Screw
I41122
HEADLAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT
Adjust the aim vertically:
Adjust the headlamp aim into the specified range by turning aiming screw with a screwdriver.
NOTICE:
The final turn of the aiming screw should be made in the
clockwise direction. If the screw is tightened excessively,
loosen it and then retighten it, so that the final turn of the
screw is in the clockwise direction.
HINT:
Perform low-beam aim adjustment.
The headlamp aim moves up when turning the aiming
screw clockwise, and moves down when turning the aiming screw counterclockwise.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3494
65-9
LIGHTING
-
LH HEADLAMP ASSY
LH HEADLAMP ASSY
6512B-01
COMPONENTS
Headlamp Protector
Retainer LWR LH
Headlamp Protector
Retainer Upper LH
Headlamp Bracket
LWR LH
LH Headlamp Assy
Headlamp, No.2 Bulb
Headlamp, No.1 Bulb
Clearance Lamp Bulb
Clearance Lamp
Socket & Wire
Headlamp Unit LH
I39810
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3486
65-10
LIGHTING
-
LH HEADLAMP ASSY
6512C-01
OVERHAUL
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
COMPONENTS: See page 65-9
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE RADIATOR GRILLE (SEE PAGE 76-2 )
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 76-2 )
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD SUB-ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 76-2 )
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER (SEE PAGE 76-2 )
5.
(a)
REMOVE LH HEADLAMP ASSY
Remove the 2 screws.
(b)
Pull out the LH headlamp assy forward, then release the
pin and the headlamp bracket.
Disconnect the connectors, and remove the LH head
lamp assy.
I40998
Pin
(c)
Bracket
I40999
6.
(a)
REMOVE HEADLAMP, NO.1 BULB
Remove the headlamp, No.1 bulb as shown in the illustration.
E54941
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3487
65-1 1
LIGHTING
-
LH HEADLAMP ASSY
7.
(a)
REMOVE HEADLAMP, NO.2 BULB
Remove the headlamp, No.2 bulb as shown in the illustration.
8.
(a)
REMOVE CLEARANCE LAMP BULB
Remove the clearance lamp bulb and the socket as
shown in the illustration.
Remove the clearance lamp bulb from the socket as
shown in the illustration.
E51840
(b)
E74195
9.
10.
REMOVE CLEARANCE LAMP SOCKET & WIRE
REMOVE HEADLAMP UNIT LH
11.
INSTALL HEADLAMP PROTECTOR RETAINER
UPPER LH
HINT:
To minimize damage to the headlamp unit in case of a collision,
the stays for the headlamp unit have been constructed to break
off. The stays are available as supply parts for low-cost repair.
(a)
Cut off the part shaded in the illustration and sand smooth
with sandpaper.
NOTICE:
After cutting off the part, place the headlamp protector retainer upper LH against the bosses and gradually file away
until installation is possible.
E52144
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3488
65-12
LIGHTING
E52145
-
LH HEADLAMP ASSY
(b)
Install the headlamp protector retainer upper LH with the
2 screws.
12.
INSTALL HEADLAMP PROTECTOR RETAINER LWR
LH
HINT:
To minimize damage to the headlamp unit in case of a collision,
the stays for the headlamp unit have been constructed to break
off. The stays are available as supply parts for low-cost repair.
(a)
Cut off the part shaded in the illustration and sand smooth
with sandpaper.
NOTICE:
After cutting off the part, place the headlamp protector retainer LWR LH against the bosses and gradually file away
until installation is possible.
E52179
(b)
E52147
Install the headlamp protector retainer LWR LH with the
2 screws.
13. INSTALL HEADLAMP BRACKET LWR LH
HINT:
To minimize damage to the headlamp unit in case of a collision,
the stays for the headlamp unit have been constructed to break
off. The stays are available as supply parts for low-cost repair.
(a) Cut off the part shaded in the illustration and sand smooth
with sandpaper.
NOTICE:
After cutting off the part, place the headlamp bracket LWR
LH against the bosses and gradually file away until installation is possible.
E52146
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3489
65-13
LIGHTING
(b)
-
LH HEADLAMP ASSY
Install the headlamp bracket LWR LH with the screw.
E52149
14.
15.
16.
17.
VEHICLE PREPARATION FOR HEADLAMP AIM ADJUSTMENT (SEE PAGE 65-14 )
PREPARATION FOR HEADLAMP AIMING (Using a screen) (SEE PAGE 65-14 )
HEADLAMP AIMING INSPECTION (SEE PAGE 65-14 )
HEADLAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT (SEE PAGE 65-14 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3490
65-19
LIGHTING
-
FOG LAMP ASSY LH
6512F-01
ADJUSTMENT
1.
(a)
VEHICLE PREPARATION FOR FOGLAMP AIM ADJUSTMENT
Prepare the vehicle:
Ensure there is no damage or deformation to the body around the headlamps.
Fill the fuel tank.
Make sure that the oil is filled to the specified level.
Make sure that the coolant is filled to the specified level.
Inflate the tires to the appropriate pressure.
Place the spare tire, tools, and jack in their original position.
Unload the trunk.
Sit a person of average weight (68 kg, 150 lbs) in the driver’s seat.
2.
(a)
PREPARATION FOR FOGLAMP AIMING
Prepare the vehicle according to the following conditions:
Place the vehicle in a location that is dark enough
to clearly observe the cutoff line. The cutoff line is
a distinct line, below which light from the headlamps
can be observed and above which it cannot.
Place the vehicle at a 90 angle to the wall.
Create a 7.62 m (25 ft) distance between the vehicle
and the wall.
Place the vehicle on a level surface.
Bounce the vehicle up and down to settle the suspension.
NOTICE:
A distance of 7.62 m (25 ft) between the vehicle and the wall
is necessary for proper aim adjustment. If unavailable, secure a distance of exactly 3 m (9.84 ft) for check and adjustment. (The target zone will change with the distance so follow the instructions in the illustration.)
(b) Prepare a piece of thick white paper to use as a screen.
(c) Draw a vertical line down the center of screen (V line).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3496
65-20
LIGHTING
-
FOG LAMP ASSY LH
(d) Set the screen as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Stand the screen perpendicular to the ground.
Align the V line on the screen with the center of the vehicle.
Aligning distance is 7.62 m (25 ft):
Aligning distance is 3 m (9.84 ft):
V RH Line
V RH Line
90
90
V Line
V Line
7.62 m (25 ft)
3 m (9.84 ft)
V LH Line
V LH Line
H Line
H Line
90
7.62 m (25 ft)
90
3 m (9.84 ft)
I41220
(e)
V LH Line
V Line
V RH Line
H Line
Ground
I33423
Draw base lines (H line, V LH, V RH lines) on the screen
as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Mark the fog lamp bulb center marks on the screen. If the center
mark cannot be observed on the fog lamp, use the center of the
fog lamp bulb or the manufacturer’s name marked on the fog
lamp as the center mark.
(1) H Line (Fog lamp height):
Draw a horizontal line across the screen so that it
passes through the center marks. The H line should
be at the same height as the fog lamp bulb center
marks of the low-beam fog lamps.
(2) V LH Line, V RH Line (Center mark position of lefthand (LH) and right-hand (RH) fog lamps):
Draw two vertical lines so that they intersect the H
Line at each center mark.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3497
65-21
LIGHTING
-
FOG LAMP ASSY LH
3.
(a)
FOGLAMP AIMING INSPECTION
Cover or disconnect the connector of the fog lamp on the opposite side to prevent light from the fog
lamp not being inspected from affecting fog lamp aiming inspection.
(b) Start the engine.
NOTICE:
Engine rpm must be 1,500 or more.
(c)
Turn on the fog lamp and make sure that the cutoff line falls within the specified area, as shown in the
illustration.
Aligning distance is 7.62 m (25 ft):
V LH Line
V RH Line
Aligning distance is 3 m (9.84 ft):
93 - 172 mm
(3.66 - 6.77 in.)
H Line
V LH Line
37 - 68 mm
(1.45 - 2.67 in.)
V RH Line
H Line
I41221
Aiming Screw
4.
(a)
FOGLAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT
Adjust the fog lamp aim into the specified range by turning
aiming screw with a screwdriver.
NOTICE:
The final turn of the aiming screw should be made in the
clockwise direction. If the screw is tightened excessively,
loosen it and then retighten it, so that the final turn of the
screw is in the clockwise direction.
I30351
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3498
65-18
LIGHTING
-
FOG LAMP ASSY LH
FOG LAMP ASSY LH
6512E-01
OVERHAUL
HINT:
1.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 76-2 )
: 2 Claws
: 3 Claws
2.
(a)
REMOVE FOG LAMP PROTECTOR LH
Disengage the 2 claws, and remove the fog lamp protector RH.
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FOG LAMP ASSY LH
Disconnect the connector.
Disengage the 3 claws, and remove the fog lamp assy LH.
4.
(a)
REMOVE FOG LAMP BULB
Remove the fog lamp bulb as shown in the illustration.
I39806
I39807
I39808
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
REMOVE BEARING FOG LAMP
REMOVE FOG LAMP LAMP UNIT LH
VEHICLE PREPARATION FOR FOGLAMP AIM ADJUSTMENT (SEE PAGE 65-19 )
PREPARATION FOR FOGLAMP AIMING (SEE PAGE 65-19 )
FOGLAMP AIMING INSPECTION (SEE PAGE 65-19 )
FOGLAMP AIMING ADJUSTMENT (SEE PAGE 65-19 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3495
65-22
LIGHTING
-
REAR COMBINATION LAMP ASSY LH
REAR COMBINATION LAMP ASSY LH
6512G-01
OVERHAUL
HINT:
1.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LAMP SERVICE COVER LH
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LAMP ASSY LH
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 2 nuts and the rear combination lamp assy
LH.
I30352
3.
4.
(a)
(b)
5.
6.
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LAMP LENS GASKET RH
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LAMP BULB
Remove the rear combination lamp bulb and the socket and wire.
Remove the rear combination lamp bulb from the socket and wire.
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LAMP SOCKET AND WIRE SUB-ASSY LH
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LAMP LENS LH
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3499
65-23
LIGHTING
-
LICENSE PLATE LAMP ASSY
LICENSE PLATE LAMP ASSY
6512H-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
REMOVE ASSIST STRAP HOLE COVER (SEE PAGE 75-20 )
2.
REMOVE ASSIST STRAP ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 75-20 )
3.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM PANEL ASSY (SEE PAGE 75-20 )
4.
REMOVE BACK DOOR LOCK ASSY (SEE PAGE 75-20 )
5.
REMOVE BACK DOOR HANDLE ASSY OUTSIDE (SEE PAGE 75-20 )
6.
REMOVE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR GARNISH SUB-ASSY OUTSIDE
(SEE PAGE 76-13 )
7.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE LICENSE PLATE LAMP ASSY
Remove the 4 screws and the 2 license plate lamp lenses.
Remove the license plate lamp assy from the luggage
compartment door garnish sub-assy outside.
I30353
8.
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOCK ASSY (SEE PAGE 75-20 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3500
65-24
LIGHTING
-
CENTER STOP LAMP ASSY
CENTER STOP LAMP ASSY
6512I-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
REMOVE BACK WINDOW PANEL TRIM UPPER (SEE PAGE 75-20 )
2.
REMOVE CENTER STOP LAMP SOCKET & WIRE
(a) Disconnect the connector, and remove the center stop lamp socket & wire.
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CENTER STOP LAMP ASSY
Remove the 2 screws.
Disengage the 4 claws, and remove the center stop lamp
assy.
I30354
4.
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE CENTER STOP LAMP GASKET
INSTALL CENTER STOP LAMP ASSY
Remove adhesive tape from the body.
Wipe off stains with a cleaner.
Install the center stop lamp assy with the 2 screws.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3501
65-25
LIGHTING
-
HEADLAMP DIMMER SWITCH ASSY
HEADLAMP DIMMER SWITCH ASSY
6512J-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER LWR (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
2.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER UPR (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE HEADLAMP DIMMER SWITCH ASSY
Disconnect the connector.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw, and remove the
headlamp dimmer switch assy.
NOTICE:
Pressing the claw hard breaks the claw.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
: Claw
I39848
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3502
65-4
LIGHTING
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
6511Y-01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
Connector Front View:
C13
E11948
(b)
(c)
(d)
HEADLAMP DIMMER SWITCH ASSY
Inspect light control switch.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
12 - 16
13 - 16
14 - 16
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
14 - 16
TAIL
Below 1 Ω
13 - 16
14 - 16
HEAD
Below 1 Ω
12 - 16
AUTO
Below 1 Ω
Inspect headlamp dimmer switch.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
16 - 17
LOW
Below 1 Ω
7 - 16
HIGH
Below 1 Ω
7 - 16
8 - 16
FLASH
Below 1 Ω
Inspect turn signal switch.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2-3
Right turn
Below 1 Ω
1-2
2-3
Neutral
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Left turn
Below 1 Ω
w/ Front Fog Lamp:
Inspect front fog light switch.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
10 - 11
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
10 - 11
ON
Below 1 Ω
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3481
65-5
LIGHTING
2.
(a)
Connector Front View:
A10
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
HAZARD WARNING SWITCH ASSY
w/o navigation system:
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A10-8 - A10-11
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
A10-8 - A10-11
ON
Below 1 Ω
E72987
(b)
Connector Front View:
M3
w/ navigation system:
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
M3-3 - M3-8
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
M3-3 - M3-8
ON
Below 1 Ω
E74072
ON
OFF
3.
(a)
FRONT DOOR COURTESY LAMP SWITCH ASSY
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 - Body ground
OFF
(When shaft is pressed)
10 kΩ or higher
1 - Body ground
ON
(When shaft is not
pressed)
Below 1 Ω
E71371
ON
OFF
4.
(a)
REAR DOOR COURTESY LAMP SWITCH ASSY
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 - Body ground
OFF
(When shaft is pressed)
10 kΩ or higher
1 - Body ground
ON
(When shaft is not
pressed)
Below 1 Ω
E71371
5.
(a)
Connector Front View:
R12
BACK DOOR LOCK ASSY
Inspect back door courtesy lamp switch assy.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1-2
Back door is closed
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Back door is open
Below 1 Ω
E74073
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3482
65-6
LIGHTING
6.
(a)
Connector Front View:
I16
(b)
E69434
E50228
(c)
7.
(a)
Connector Front View:
R11
(b)
E69434
E50228
(c)
8.
(a)
Connector Front View:
O5
E72986
9.
(a)
Connector Front View:
D5
D6
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
ROOM LAMP ASSY NO.1
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1-2
1-3
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to the terminal 1 and negative (-) lead to the terminal 2, then check
that the lamp comes on when the switch is in the DOOR
position.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to the terminal 1 and negative (-) lead to the terminal 3, then check
that the lamp comes on when the switch is in the ON position.
ROOM LAMP ASSY NO.2
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1-2
1-3
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to the terminal 1 and negative (-) lead to the terminal 2, then check
that the lamp comes on when the switch is in the DOOR
position.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to the terminal 1 and negative (-) lead to the terminal 3, then check
that the lamp comes on when the switch is in the ON position.
MAP LAMP ASSY
Inspect the map lamp in the overhead J/B.
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 12 and negative (-) lead to terminal 1, then
check that the lamp comes on when the switch is in
the ON position.
(2) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 12 and negative (-) lead to terminal 7, then
check that the lamp comes on when the switch is in
the DOOR position.
COURTESY LAMP ASSY
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and negative (-) lead to terminal 2, then check that the
lamp comes on.
E69342
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3483
65-7
LIGHTING
10.
(a)
11.
(a)
12.
(a)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
LH VISOR ASSY
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to one of the terminals and the negative (-) lead to other
terminal, then check that the lamp comes on when the switch is in the ON position.
RH VISOR ASSY
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to one of the terminals and the negative (-) lead to other
terminal, then check that the lamp comes on when the switch is in the ON position.
GLOVE BOX LAMP ASSY
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to one of the terminals and the negative (-) lead to other
terminal, then check that the lamp comes on when the switch is in the ON position.
Connector Front View:
13.
(a)
KEY CYLINDER LAMP
w/ Theft deterrent system:
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and negative (-) lead to terminal 6, then check that the
lamp comes on.
(b)
w/o Theft deterrent system:
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and negative (-) lead to terminal 1, then check that the
lamp comes on.
14.
(a)
HEADLAMP RELAY
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
T7
E74066
Connector Front View:
I14
E69342
3
1
4
4
3
1
2
Tester connection
Specified condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 - 2)
2
Z09181
15.
(a)
TAIL LAMP RELAY
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Specified condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 - 2)
B16200
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3484
65-8
LIGHTING
16.
(a)
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
FOG LAMP RELAY
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Specified condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 - 2)
B16200
17.
(a)
DRL NO.2 RELAY
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Specified condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 - 2)
E64835
18.
(a)
DRL NO.3 RELAY
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Specified condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 - 2)
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
(When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 - 2)
E74095
19.
(a)
DRL NO.4 RELAY
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Specified condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 - 2)
E64835
2
4
S15 1
3
Free Pushed in
E65594
20.
(a)
STOP LAMP SWITCH ASSY
Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Switch position
Specified resistance
1-2
Switch pin free
Below 1 Ω
3-4
Switch pin free
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Switch pin pushed in
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
Switch pin pushed in
Below 1 Ω
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3485
65-2
LIGHTING
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
6511X-01
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
Connector Front View:
T8
(b)
INSPECT TURN SIGNAL FLASHER CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the turn signal flasher
relay.
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
E15683
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 - body ground
Turn ignition switch ON
10 to 14 V
1 - body ground
Turn ignition switch OFF
Below 1 V
4 - body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
7 - body ground
Always
Below 1 V
(c)
(d)
Reconnect the connector to the turn signal flasher.
Measure the voltage according to the valve(s) in the table
below.
Standard:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2 - body ground
Hazard switch OFF → ON
0V ⇔ 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 times per minute)
2 - body ground
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF → ON
0V ⇔ 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 times per minute)
3 - body ground
Hazard switch OFF → ON
0V ⇔ 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 times per minute)
3 - body ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF → ON
0V ⇔ 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 times per minute)
5 - body ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF → ON
10 to 14 V → 0 V
6 - body ground
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF → ON
10 to 14 V → 0 V
8 - body ground
Hazard switch OFF → ON
10 to 14 V → 0 V
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3479
65-3
LIGHTING
2.
(a)
Connector Front View:
T9
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECT TOWING CONVERTER RELAY
Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the table
below.
E74074
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 - Body ground
Light control switch OFF → TAIL
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
2 - Body ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF → ON
0 ⇔ 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 times per minute)
2 - Body ground
Brake pedal OFF → ON (depressed)
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
3 - Body ground
Light control switch OFF → TAIL
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
4 - Body ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF → ON
0 ⇔ 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 times per minute)
5 - Body ground
Always
Below 1 V
6 - Body ground
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF → ON
0 ⇔ 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 times per minute)
6 - Body ground
Brake pedal OFF → ON (depressed)
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
8 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
9 - Body ground
Brake pedal OFF → ON (depressed)
10 to 14 V
10 - Body ground
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF → ON
0 ⇔ 10 to 14 V (60 to 120 times per minute)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3480
65-1
LIGHTING
-
LIGHTING SYSTEM
LIGHTING SYSTEM
650PD-07
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
PRECAUTION OF HEADLAMP BULB REPLACEMENT
If even a thin film of oil is left on the surface of the halogen lamp, the bulb may be damaged because
the lamp will burn at a higher temperature.
Handle any halogen lamp with great care. Dropping, hitting or damaging the bulb, in any way, may
result in it exploding and shattering because the internal pressure is high.
Always prepare a new bulb for immediate replacement. While replacing the bulb, the lens may attract
dust and moisture if removed from the vehicle for too long.
Always use a bulb of the same wattage for replacement.
Firmly reinstall the socket after bulb replacement. The lens may become cloudy or the light cavity may
fill with water through the gaps around the socket.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3478
66-7
WIPER & WASHER
-
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSY
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSY
660HP-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER ARM COVER
2.
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM & BLADE ASSY LH
(a) Stop the windshield wiper motor assy at the automatic stop position.
(b) Remove the nut and the FR wiper arm & blade assy LH.
3.
REMOVE FR WIPER ARM & BLADE ASSY RH
(a) Remove the nut and the FR wiper arm & blade assy RH.
4.
(a)
: 6 Claws
: 9 Claws
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER
SUB-ASSY
Disengage the 6 claws.
I30311
(b)
(c)
Remove the 2 clips.
Disengage the 9 claws, and remove the cowl top ventilator louver sub-assy.
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR & LINK ASSY
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 2 bolts.
Remove the windshield wiper motor & link assy by disengaging the pin as shown in the illustration.
I30312
I30492
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3509
66-8
WIPER & WASHER
-
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSY
6.
(a)
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSY
Using a screwdriver, disengage the meshing of the 2 rods
at the crank arm pivot of the windshield wiper motor assy.
(b)
Using a torx socket wrench, remove the 2 bolts and the
windshield wiper motor assy.
7.
(a)
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSY
Apply MP grease to the clank arm pivot of the windshield
wiper motor assy.
Using a torx socket wrench, install the windshield wiper
motor assy with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.39 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
E50396
E50397
E50398
(b)
E50398
8.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR & LINK ASSY
Temporarily install the windshield wiper & Link assy by engaging the pin.
Install the windshield wiper motor & link assy with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 7.0 N⋅m (71 kgf⋅cm, 61 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the connecter.
I39852
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3510
66-9
WIPER & WASHER
Wire Brush
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSY
9.
(a)
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM & BLADE ASSY RH
Stop the windshield wiper motor assy at the automatic
stop position.
(b)
Scrape off the serration part of the wiper arm with a round
file or equivalent.
Clean the wiper pivot serration with a wire brush.
(c)
Wiper Arm Serration
-
Wiper Pivot Serration
E58837
24.2 mm (0.95 in.)
(d)
Install the front wiper arm & blade assy RH with the nut to
the position shown in the illustration.
Torque: 24 N⋅m (245 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
HINT:
Hold down the arm hinge by hand in order to fasten the nut.
23.6 mm (0.93 in.)
17.0 mm (0.66 in.)
26.3 mm (1.04 in.)
I30319
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3511
66-10
WIPER & WASHER
10.
(a)
Wiper Arm Serration
(b)
Wire Brush
-
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSY
INSTALL FR WIPER ARM & BLADE ASSY LH
Scrape off the serration part of the wiper arm with a round
file or equivalent.
Clean the wiper pivot serration with a wire brush.
Wiper Pivot Serration
E58837
(c)
28.8 mm (1.13 in.)
HINT:
Hold down the arm hinge by hand in order to fasten the nut.
(d) Operate the wiper while running water or washer fluid
over the window, and check the wiping condition and that
the front wiper does not scrape against the body.
34.3 mm
(1.35 in.)
23.4 mm
(0.92 in.)
68.5 mm (2.70 in.)
Install the front wiper arm & blade assy LH with the 2 nuts
to the position shown in the illustration.
Torque: 24 N⋅m (245 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
I30320
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3512
66-1 1
WIPER & WASHER
-
WIPER RUBBER LH
WIPER RUBBER LH
660HQ-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
REMOVE FR WIPER BLADE LH
(a) Remove the front wiper blade LH from the front wiper arm LH.
NOTICE:
Do not fold down the front wiper arm with the front wiper blade removed from it.
2.
REMOVE WIPER RUBBER LH
(a) Remove the front wiper rubber LH from the front wiper blade.
(b) Remove the 2 wiper rubber backing plates from the wiper rubber LH.
3.
(a)
INSTALL WIPER RUBBER LH
Install the 2 wiper rubber backing plates to the wiper rubber LH.
NOTICE:
Install the backing plates in the correct direction.
Curve
E59361
(b)
Install the wiper rubber LH so that the head part (larger
side) of the wiper rubber faces the arm axle side.
NOTICE:
Push the front wiper blade into the grooves of the wiper
rubber to engage them completely.
E57398
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3513
66-12
WIPER & WASHER
-
REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSY
REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSY
660HR-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
REMOVE RR WIPER ARM & BLADE ASSY
(a) Remove the rear wiper arm cover.
(b) Remove the nut and the RR wiper arm & blade assy.
2.
REMOVE REAR WIPER MOTOR GROMMET
3.
REMOVE ASSIST STRAP HOLE COVER (SEE PAGE 75-20 )
4.
REMOVE ASSIST STRAP ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 75-20 )
5.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM PANEL ASSY (SEE PAGE 75-20 )
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSY
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 3 bolts and the rear wiper motor assy.
7.
(a)
INSTALL REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSY
Install the rear wiper motor assy with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the connector.
I30314
(b)
I30314
Installation
Position Mark
Rear Wiper
Grommet
8.
(a)
INSTALL REAR WIPER MOTOR GROMMET
As shown in the illustration, install the rear wiper motor
grommet with its position mark upside.
9.
(a)
INSTALL RR WIPER ARM & BLADE ASSY
Stop the rear wiper motor assy at the automatic stop position.
I30315
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3514
66-13
WIPER & WASHER
(b)
(c)
Wiper Arm Serration
Wire Brush
-
REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSY
Scrape off the wiper arm serration with a round file or
equivalent.
Clean the rear wiper pivot serration with a wire brush.
Wiper Pivot Serration
E58837
(d)
(e)
Ceramic Line
I30316
Install the RR wiper arm & blade assy in the position
shown in the illustration.
Install the RR wiper arm & blade assy with the nut.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
HINT:
Hold down the arm hinge by hand in order to fasten the nut.
(f)
Install the rear wiper arm cover.
(g) Operate the wiper while running water or washer fluid
over the window, and check the wiping condition and that
the rear wiper does not scrape against the body.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3515
66-14
WIPER & WASHER
-
REAR WIPER RUBBER
REAR WIPER RUBBER
660HS-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
(a)
REMOVE REAR WIPER BLADE ASSY
Raise the rear wiper blade assy to the position where the
claw disengages with a click sound as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the claw.
Claw Position
I40017
(b)
Pull the rear wiper blade straight toward the left side of the
vehicle to remove it from the rear wiper arm.
NOTICE:
Do not fold down the rear wiper arm with the rear wiper
blade removed from it.
I30318
Slightly (Push)
Raise
Stopper
(Blade Base End)
Tip End
Pull Out
I40018
2.
(a)
REMOVE REAR WIPER RUBBER
Make the rear wiper rubber protrude from the base end
stopper of the rear wiper blade.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly pull out the wiper rubber as the backing
plates may be deformed or blade claws may be damaged.
HINT:
When removing the wiper rubber, pull it out from the base
end, as the wiper blade has more space at the base end
(section B as shown in the illustration).
Slightly pushing the wiper blade claw and the surrounding
central area will allow the rubber to be pulled out more
easily.
Base End
I40019
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3516
66-15
WIPER & WASHER
-
REAR WIPER RUBBER
(b)
Pull out the rear wiper rubber from the rear wiper blade
completely.
3.
(a)
INSTALL REAR WIPER RUBBER
Insert the rear wiper rubber from the claw position in the
middle of the rear wiper blade to the base end.
(b)
After passing the rear wiper rubber through the base end
claw, make it stick out from the base end stopper to pass
it through the tip end claw.
(c)
Make sure that the rear wiper blade claws are fit in the rear
wiper rubber groove.
Pull Out
I40020
Base End
Tip End
I40021
Base End
Base End
Stopper
Tip End
I40022
Slide
(Rubber)
I40023
Raise
HINT:
If the blade claws are not fit in the rubber groove, slide the
rubber several times to make the blade claw fit.
Applying a small amount of the window washer fluid to the
rubber makes the blade claws fit easily.
Raise the middle part of the wiper rubber as shown in the
illustration to maintain a longer stroke length for sliding
the rubber.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly slide the wiper rubber as the backing plates
may be deformed or the blade claw may be damaged.
Slide
I40024
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3517
66-16
WIPER & WASHER
-
WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSY
WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSY
660HT-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER LWR (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
2.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER UPR (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSY
Disconnect the connector.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw, and remove the
windshield wiper switch assy.
NOTICE:
Pressing the claw hard breaks the claw.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
: Claw
I39843
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3518
66-17
WIPER & WASHER
-
WASHER NOZZLE
WASHER NOZZLE
660HU-01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT WASHER NOZZLE
With the engine running, check that the washer fluid hits in the range indicated by the hatched areas
on the windshield and the rear window.
HINT:
This washer nozzle does not have an adjustment function because this nozzle is a spray type.
Front:
A
B
D
C
A: 206.9 mm (8.14 in.)
B: 401.8 mm (15.82 in.)
C: 114.7 mm (4.51 in.)
D: 385.6 mm (15.18 in.)
Rear:
A
H I
B
J
F G
K
D
C
E
A: 111.9 mm (4.4 in.)
B: 43.4 mm (1.7 in.)
C: 106.7 mm (4.2 in)
D: 150 mm (5.9 in.)
E: 181.8 mm (7.15 in.)
D
F: 185.6 mm (7.3 in.)
G: 60.5 mm (2.38 in.)
H: 51.4 mm (2.02 in.)
I: 6.5 mm (0.25 in.)
J: 105 mm (4.13 in.)
K: 200.8 mm (7.9 in.)
I39811
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3519
66-4
WIPER & WASHER
-
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
660HH-01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSY
Continuity Check
(1) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard:
Front Wiper Switch
Connector Front View:
C14
I30405
Tester connection
Switch operation
Specified condition
7 (+1) - 17 (+B)
MIST
Below 1 Ω
7 (+1) - 16 (+S)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
7 (+1) - 16 (+S)
INT
Below 1 Ω
7 (+1) - 17 (+B)
LO
Below 1 Ω
8 (+2) - 17 (+B)
HI
Below 1 Ω
Tester connection
Switch operation
Specified condition
2 (EW) - 11 (WF)
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
2 (EW) - 11 (WF)
ON
Below 1 Ω
Front Washer Switch
Rear Wiper and Washer Switch
(b)
Tester connection
Switch operation
Specified condition
2 (EW) - 12 (WR)
WASH
(Rear wiper switch OFF
side)
Below 1 Ω
2 (EW) - 10 (+1R)
2 (EW) - 12 (WR)
2 (EW) - 13 (C1R)
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
2 (EW) - 13 (C1R)
INT
Below 1 Ω
2 (EW) - 10 (+1R)
ON
Below 1 Ω
2 (EW) - 10 (+1R)
2 (EW) - 12 (WR)
WASH
(Rear wiper switch OFF
side)
Below 1 Ω
Intermittent Operation Check
(1) Connect the voltmeter (+) terminal to terminal 7 (+1)
of the connector, the voltmeter (-) terminals to terminal 2 (EW) of the connector.
(2) Connect the battery (+) to terminal 17 (+B) of the
connector, the battery (-) to terminal 2 (EW) and 16
(+S) of the connector.
(3) Turn the wiper switch to INT.
(4) Connect the battery (+) to terminal 16 (+S) of the
connector for 5 seconds.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3506
66-5
WIPER & WASHER
-
(5)
FAST:
Connect the battery (-)
to terminal 16 (+S)
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
Connect the battery (-) to terminal 16 (+S) of the
connector. Operate the intermittent wiper relay and
check voltage between terminal 7 (+1) and terminal
2 (EW).
SLOW: Connect the battery (-)
to terminal 16 (+S)
7 (+1) ⇔ 2 (EW)
Voltage between terminals
1.6 ± 1 seconds
(c)
Washer
Switch
ON
OFF
10 to 14 V
7 (+1) ⇔ 2 (EW)
0V
Voltage
between
terminals
Approx. 0.3
seconds
Approx. 2.2
seconds E74268
2.
(a)
Connector Front View:
F6
(b)
E34081
(c)
9.53 + 5
- 10
Automatic Stop Position
I19521
10.7 ± 5 seconds
E56399
Operation Check (Front Wiper)
(1) Turn the wiper switch OFF.
(2) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 17 (+B) and the negative (-) lead to terminals
2 (EW) and 16 (+S).
(3) Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to
terminal 7 (+1) and the negative (-) lead to terminal
2 (EW).Turn the washer switch ON and OFF and
check voltage between terminal 7 (+1) and terminal
2 (EW).
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSY
LO Operation Check
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 1 (+1) and the negative (-) lead to terminal 5
(E), check that the motor operates at low speed.
HI Operation Check
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 4 (+2) and the negative (-) lead to terminal 5
(E), and check that the motor operates at high
speed.
Automatic Stop Operation Check
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 1 (+1) and the negative (-) lead to terminal 5
(E), and operate the motor at low speed and stop
the motor operation anywhere except at the stop
position by disconnecting positive (+) lead from terminal 1 (+1).
(2) Connect terminals 1 (+1) and 3 (S).
(3) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 2 (B), and check that the motor stops running
at the stop position after the motor operates again.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3507
66-6
WIPER & WASHER
REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSY
Operation Check
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 1 (+B) and the negative (-) lead to terminal 3
(LS), and check that the motor operates.
NOTICE:
The body earth should be connected.
R18
E34836
2
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
3.
(a)
Connector Front View:
1
-
3
E74201
(b)
Ceramic Line
I30316
Automatic Stop Position Operation Check
(1) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 1 (+B) and the negative (-) lead to terminal 3
(LS).
NOTICE:
The body earth should be connected.
(2) With the motor being rotated, disconnect terminal 1
(+B) and terminal 3 (LS) to stop the motor operation
at any position except the automatic stop position.
(3) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 1 (+B), and check that the motor is restarted
and automatically stopped.
NOTICE:
The body earth should be connected.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3508
66-3
WIPER & WASHER
-
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
660HG-01
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
F14
1.
(a)
FRONT WASHER MOTOR
Operation Check
(1) Fill the washer jar with the washer fluid.
(2) Connect the positive battery (+) lead to terminal 1
of the windshield washer motor and pump assy, and
the negative battery (-) lead to terminal 2. Check
that washer fluid flows from the washer jar.
2.
(a)
REAR WASHER MOTOR
Operation Check
(1) Fill the washer jar with the washer fluid.
(2) Connect the positive battery (+) lead to terminal 1
of the windshield washer motor and pump assy, and
the negative battery (-) lead to terminal 2. Check
that washer fluid flows from the washer jar.
E66575
R21
E67367
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
LEVEL WARNING SWITCH ASSY
Check washer level warning switch continuity.
Check that no continuity exists between terminals with switch OFF (float up).
Check that continuity exists between terminals with switch ON (float down).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3505
66-1
WIPER & WASHER
-
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
6605A-09
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
(b)
PRECAUTION OF WASHER NOZZLE ADJUSTMENT
Do not clean or adjust the washer nozzle with a safety pin, etc. because;
(1) the washer nozzle tip is made of resin and could be damaged.
(2) adjustment is not necessary because the washer nozzle is spray type.
In case the washer nozzle is clogged with wax, etc., remove it and clean the nozzle hole with a soft
resin brush, etc.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3503
66-2
WIPER & WASHER
-
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
660HF-02
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected Area
See page
Front wipers and washers do not operate.
1. WIPER/WASHER Fuse
2. Front Wiper Switch
3. Wire Harness or Connector
66-4
-
Front wipers do not operate in LO or HI.
1. WIPER Fuse
2. Front Wiper Switch
3. Front Wiper Motor
4. Wire Harness or Connector
66-4
66-4
-
Front wipers do not operate in INT.
1. Front Wiper Switch
2. Front Wiper Motor
3. Wire Harness or Connector
66-4
66-4
-
Front washer motor does not operate.
1. WASHER Fuse
2. Front Washer Switch
3. Front Washer Motor
4. Wire Harness or Connector
66-4
66-3
-
Front wipers do not operate when washer switch is ON.
1. Front Wiper Switch
2. Front Wiper Motor
3. Wire Harness or Connector
66-4
66-4
-
Rear wipers and washers do not operate.
1. RR WIP Fuse
2. Rear Wiper and Washer Switch
3. Wire Harness or Connector
66-4
-
Rear wipers do not operate in INT.
1. Rear Wiper and Washer Switch
2. Rear Wiper Motor
3. Wire Harness or Connector
66-4
66-4
-
Rear washer motor does not operate.
1. WASHER Fuse
2. Rear Wiper and Washer Switch
3. Rear Washer Motor
4. Wire Harness or Connector
66-4
66-3
-
Rear wipers do not operate when washer switch is ON.
1. Rear Wiper and Washer Switch
2. Rear Wiper Motor
3. Wire Harness or Connector
66-4
66-4
-
Washer fluid does not operate.
1. Washer Hose and Nozzle
When the wiper switch is OFF, the wiper blade does not retract
or the retract position is wrong.
1. *1Wiper Motor
Washer fluid level warning does not operate.
66-7
1. Level Warning Switch Assy
2. Combination Meter Assy
3. Wire Harness or Connector
66-7
05-1882
-
*1: Inspect wiper arm and blade set position
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3504
67-17
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
W/HOLDER ANTENNA ASSY
W/HOLDER ANTENNA ASSY
6702K-04
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
COMPONENTS: See page 76-21
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER NO.2 (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 76-2 )
2 Clamps
5.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE W/HOLDER ANTENNA ASSY
Disconnect the connector,and remove the bolt.
Remove the 2 clamps.
(c)
(d)
Tie the string at the tip of the cable of the w/holder antenna assy.
Remove the antenna nut and ornament antenna.
(e)
Remove the nut and w/holder antenna assy.
I30432
String
I30433
I30434
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3536
67-18
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
-
W/HOLDER ANTENNA ASSY
INSTALL W/HOLDER ANTENNA ASSY
Install the w/holder antenna assy with the nut.
Install the antenna nut and ornament antenna.
Use the string to put the cable of the w/holder antenna assy.
Install the 2 clamps.
Connect the connector, install the bolt.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3537
67-15
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
AMPLIFIER ANTENNA ASSY
AMPLIFIER ANTENNA ASSY
6716C-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 76-21
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSY (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
1.
HINT:
Refer to the procedures up to ”REMOVE ROOF HEAD LINING ASSY”.
2.
(a)
REMOVE ROOF SIDE RAIL BRACKET LH
Remove the 4 bolts and roof side rail bracket LH.
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE AMPLIFIER ANTENNA ASSY
Disconnect the 2 connectors.
Remove the 4 clamps, bolt and amplifier antenna assy.
I30429
4 Clamps
I30430
4.
INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSY (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from ”INSTALL ROOF HEAD LINING ASSY”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3534
67-14
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.3
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.3
6715X-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 76-21
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSY (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
1.
HINT:
Refer to the procedures up to ”REMOVE ROOF HEAD LINING ASSY”.
2.
REMOVE ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.3
(a) Remove the antenna cord sub assy No. 3 from the roof headlining.
3.
INSTALL ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.3
(a) Tape the antenna cord sub-assy No. 3 at the position of the roof headlining shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
The antenna cord sub assy should come to the center of the tape (100 mm x 25 mm) when taped.
Try not to touch the adhesive side of the tape when taping.
w/o Sliding Roof :
w/ Sliding Roof :
: Tape position
I30428
4.
INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSY (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from ”INSTALL ROOF HEAD LINING ASSY”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3533
67-13
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.2
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.2
670I9-03
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY W/PASSENGER AIR BAG ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-10 )
HINT:
Refer to the procedures up to ”REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY W/ PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY”.
2.
(a)
REMOVE ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSY NO.2
Remove the 4 clamps and antenna cord sub-assy.
4 Clamps
I30424
3.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY W/PASSENGER AIR BAG ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-10 )
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from ”INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY W/ PASSENGER
AIRBAG ASSY”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3532
67-32
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
POWER OUTLET SOCKET ASSY
POWER OUTLET SOCKET ASSY
6716A-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY CENTER
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ARMREST ASSY CENTER
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSY
3 Claws
2 Claws
4.
(a)
REMOVE POWER OUTLET SOCKET ASSY
Remove the power outlet socket assy together with the
console box rear cover as shown in the illustration.
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the connector.
Release the 2 claw fittings and remove the power outlet
socket assy.
I39470
I39471
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3551
67-22
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
VOLTAGE INVERTER ASSY
VOLTAGE INVERTER ASSY
67162-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ARMREST ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
4.
(a)
(b)
2 Clamps
REMOVE VOLTAGE INVERTER ASSY
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 2 clamps and the voltage inverter assy.
I38950
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3541
67-23
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
MULTI-DISPLAY CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY
MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY
67163-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE REAR SEAT ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 72-35 )
REMOVE REAR SEAT ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 72-28 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER ASSY (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY NO.2 (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY NO.3 (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM BOX RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM BOX LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR FLOOR FINISH PLATE (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
16.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEAT SUB FLOOR PANEL ASSY
(W/O RR NO.2 SEAT)
Remove the 3 bolts, 3 nuts and rear seat sub floor panel.
I30435
17.
W/o RR No.2 Seat :
(a)
(b)
REMOVE
MULTI- DISPLAY
CONTROLLER
W/BRACKET
Disconnect the connectors.
W/o RR No.2 Seat:
Remove the 2 bolts and nut and the multi-display controller w/bracket.
I39464
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3542
67-24
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
W/ RR No.2 Seat :
-
MULTI-DISPLAY CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY
(c)
W/ RR No.2 Seat:
Remove the 2 nuts and bolt and the multi-display controller w/bracket.
18.
(a)
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLER BRACKET A
Remove the 2 screws and the multi-display controller
bracket A.
19.
(a)
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLER BRACKET B
Remove the 2 screws and the multi-display controller
bracket B.
I39467
W/ RR No.2 Seat :
I39468
W/o RR No.2 Seat :
I39466
W/ RR No.2 Seat :
I39465
W/o RR No.2 Seat :
I39469
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3543
67-25
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
20.
-
MULTI-DISPLAY CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLLER SUB-ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3544
67-26
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY
TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY
67164-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
4 Claws
1.
(a)
REMOVE TELEVISION BASE
Release the 4 claws and remove the television base.
2.
(a)
REMOVE TELEVISION DISPLAY ASSY
Disconnect the connector and remove the 4 nuts and the
television display assy.
I39462
I39463
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3545
67-27
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
VIDEO(VIDEO ADAPTER) TERMINAL
VIDEO(VIDEO ADAPTER) TERMINAL
67165-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
3 Claws
4 Claws
1.
(a)
REMOVE VIDEO(VIDEO ADAPTER) TERMINAL
Remove the video (video adapter) terminal together with
the console box rear cover as shown in the illustration.
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the connector.
Release the 4 claw fittings and remove the video (video
adapter) terminal.
I39470
I39472
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3546
67-28
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
67166-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
SEPARATE BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.2 (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.3 (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
REMOVE HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
Disconnect the connector.
Disconnect the connector of cruise control main switch.
Remove the screw.
(d)
Release the 2 pin fittings and remove the steering pad
switch LH.
E62430
E62431
2 Pins
7.
8.
9.
10.
I33301
INSTALL HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-1 1)
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3547
67-2
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
6715P-01
COMPONENTS
Instrument Cluster Finish
Panel Sub-assy Center
Integration Control & Panel Assy
Radio Bracket No.1
Radio Bracket No.2
Radio Receiver Assy
Integration Control And
Panel Assy
w/ EMV Navigation System:
Multi-Display
(CRT Display) Display
Multi-display
Controller Bracket A
Multi-display
Controller Bracket B
Radio Receiver Assy
I39620
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3521
67-3
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
Antenna Cord
Sub-Assy No.2
-
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
w/ Antenna cord sub-assy No.3:
Antenna Cord
Sub-Assy No.2
Navigation Antenna Assy
Power Outlet Socket Assy
Power Outlet Socket Cover
Steering Pad Switch LH
Cigarette Lighter Assy
Power Outlet Socket Assy CTR
Cigarette Lighter Cover
Power Outlet Socket
Cover CTR
I39621
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3522
67-4
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
Antenna Cord Sub-Assy No.3
W/ Holder Antenna Assy
Front No.2 Speaker Assy
Amplifier Antenna Assy
Front No.1 Speaker Assy
Amplifier Antenna Assy
Rear Speaker Assy
Power Outlet Socket Assy RR
Voltage Inverter Assy
Power Outlet Socket
Cover RR
I39622
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3523
67-5
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
Television Display Assy
Television Base
Stereo Component Amplifier Assy
Video (Video Adapter) Terminal
Navigation Computer Cover
w/o RR No.2 Seat:
Multi- display Controller
Sub-assy
Power Outlet
Socket Assy
Multi- display Controller
Bracket A
Multi- display Controller
Bracket B
Disc Player Bracket
w/ RR No.2 Seat:
Navigation ECU
Navigation ECU Cover
Multi- display Controller
Sub-assy
Multi- display Controller
Bracket A
Multi- display Controller
Bracket B
I39623
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3524
67-1
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
6715Q-01
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
(b)
OBSERVE HANDLING AND OPERATIONAL PRECAUTIONS
Explain to the customer that when the negative terminal is disconnected from the battery, the AM/FM
channel presets in the radio receiver are cleared. If necessary, make a note of the recorded channel
information before the negative terminal is disconnected, then reset the information after the negative
terminal is reconnected.
The removal/installation of the radio receiver should be performed after all cassette tapes and audio
CDs are ejected from the radio receiver.
HINT:
If a cassette tape or audio CD cannot be ejected due to malfunction of the radio receiver, do not attempt to
remove it forcefully. Bring the vehicle to the repair plant.
(c) Fasten the earth bolt securely when the antenna cord is removed or installed.
HINT:
Failure to fasten the earth bolt securely causes noise when receiving radio waves.
(d) Do not touch the cone paper of the speaker.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3520
67-6
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
6715R-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE INTEGRATION CONTROL & PANEL ASSY
Remove the 6 bolts.
Disconnect the connectors and remove the integration
control & panel assy.
3.
REMOVE RADIO BRACKET NO.1 (W/O EMV &
NAVIGATION SYSTEM)
Remove the 4 bolts, 2 screws and radio bracket No. 1.
E51908
(a)
E51909
4.
(a)
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLER BRACKET A
(W/ EMV & NAVIGATION SYSTEM)
Remove the 7 screws and multi-display controller bracket A.
E51911
5.
(a)
REMOVE RADIO BRACKET NO.2 (W/O EMV &
NAVIGATION SYSTEM)
Remove the 4 bolts, 2 screws and radio bracket No. 2.
E51910
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3525
67-7
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
6.
(a)
-
RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLER BRACKET B
(W/ EMV & NAVIGATION SYSTEM)
Remove the 7 screws and multi-display controller bracket B.
E51912
7.
REMOVE RADIO RECEIVER ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3526
67-8
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
MULTI-DISPLAY (CRT DISPLAY) DISPLAY
MULTI-DISPLA Y (CRT DISPLAY) DISPLAY
6715S-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE INTEGRATION CONTROL & PANEL ASSY
Remove the 6 bolts.
Disconnect the connectors and remove the integration
control & panel assy.
3.
(a)
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLER BRACKET A
Remove the 7 screws and multi-display controller bracket A.
4.
(a)
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLA Y CONTROLER BRACKET B
Remove the 7 screws and multi-display controller bracket B.
I40943
E51911
E51912
5.
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLA Y (CRT DISPLAY) DISPLAY
6.
INSTALL MULTI-DISPLA Y (CRT DISPLAY) DISPLAY
HINT:
Perform the screen noise automatic adjustment when screen noise occurs (see page 05-1803 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3527
67-9
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
NAVIGATION ECU
NAVIGATION ECU
6715T-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
POWER SEAT (SEE PAGE 72-1 1)
MANUAL SEAT (SEE PAGE 72-19 )
4 Claws
2.
(a)
REMOVE NAVIGATION ECU COVER
Remove the 4 claws and the navigation ECU cover.
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE NAVIGATION ECU W/BRACKET
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 2 bolts and the navigation ECU w/ bracket.
4.
(a)
REMOVE DISC PLAYER BRACKET
Remove the 4 screws and the disc player bracket.
I39625
I39624
I39626
5.
REMOVE NAVIGATION ECU
6.
INSTALL NAVIGATION ECU
HINT:
Perform the screen noise automatic adjustment when screen noise occurs (see page 05-1803 ).
7.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
POWER SEAT (SEE PAGE 72-1 1)
MANUAL SEAT (SEE PAGE 72-19 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3528
67-10
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
FRONT NO.1 SPEAKER ASSY
FRONT NO.1 SPEAKER ASSY
6715U-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE MULTIPLEX NETWORK MASTER SWITCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 75-6 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET GARNISH LH (SEE PAGE 75-6 )
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE (SEE PAGE 75-6 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 75-6 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 75-6 )
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT NO.1 SPEAKER ASSY
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 3 screws and front No. 1 speaker assy.
7.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL FRONT NO.1 SPEAKER ASSY
Install the front No.1 speaker assy with the 3 screws.
Connect the connector.
I30421
I30421
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3529
67-1 1
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
FRONT NO.2 SPEAKER ASSY
FRONT NO.2 SPEAKER ASSY
6715V-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE MULTIPLEX NETWORK MASTER SWITCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 75-6 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET GARNISH LH (SEE PAGE 75-6 )
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE (SEE PAGE 75-6 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 75-6 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 75-6 )
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT NO.2 SPEAKER ASSY
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the screw and front No. 2 speaker assy.
I30422
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3530
67-12
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
REAR SPEAKER ASSY
REAR SPEAKER ASSY
6715W-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
COMPONENTS: See page 75-13
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE (SEE PAGE 75-13 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 75-13 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 75-13 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH (SEE PAGE 75-13 )
5.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SPEAKER ASSY
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 3 screws and rear speaker assy.
6.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL REAR SPEAKER ASSY
Install the rear speaker assy with the 3 screws.
Connect the connector.
I30423
I30423
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3531
67-16
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
AMPLIFIER ANTENNA ASSY
AMPLIFIER ANTENNA ASSY
6715Y-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 76-21
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSY (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
1.
HINT:
Refer to the procedures up to ”REMOVE ROOF HEAD LINING ASSY”.
2.
(a)
REMOVE ROOF SIDE RAIL BRACKET RH
Remove the 4 bolts and roof side rail bracket RH.
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE AMPLIFIER ANTENNA ASSY
Disconnect the 2 connectors.
Remove the 3 clamps, bolt and amplifier antenna assy.
I30494
3 Clamps
I30431
4.
INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSY (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from ”INSTALL ROOF HEAD LINING ASSY”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3535
67-20
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER ASSY
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER ASSY
67160-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER ASSY (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY NO.2 (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY NO.3 (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX REAR (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX FRONT (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR FLOOR FINISH PLATE (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM BOX RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER ASSY
Remove the 2 nuts and bolt.
Disconnect the connectors, then remove the stereo component amplifier assy.
I38962
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3539
67-19
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSY
NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSY
6715Z-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY W/PASSENGER AIR BAG ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-10 )
HINT:
Refer to the procedures up to ”REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY W/ PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSY”.
2.
(a)
3 Claws
3.
REMOVE NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSY
Release the 3 clamps and remove the 2 screws and the
navigation antenna assy.
I39639
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY W/PASSENGER AIR BAG ASSY
(SEE PAGE 71-10 )
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from ”INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY W/ PASSENGER
AIRBAG ASSY”.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3538
67-21
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
67161-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER NO.2 (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the bolt and the network gateway ECU.
I39640
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3540
67-30
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
POWER OUTLET SOCKET ASSY CTR
POWER OUTLET SOCKET ASSY CTR
67168-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
(a)
REMOVE POWER OUTLET SOCKET ASSY CTR
Turn the socket in the circumference direction as shown
in the illustration, disengage the claw between the socket
and the power point socket cover, and push out the socket
to the room side.
E03722
2.
(a)
INSTALL POWER OUTLET SOCKET ASSY CTR
Align the socket with the notch on the power point socket cover CTR and install the power socket assy
CTR by pushing it in as hard as possible.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3549
67-31
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
POWER POINT SOCKET ASSY RR
POWER POINT SOCKET ASSY RR
67169-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
(a)
Hole
REMOVE POWER POINT SOCKET ASSY RR
Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw on the power
point socket cover from the hole in the power point socket,
then pull out the power point socket approx. 10 mm (0.39
in.).
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
H06011
(b)
Trim
Body
Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw on the power
point socket cover from the body and remove the power
point socket and cover as a unit.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Disconnect the connector.
(d) Disassemble the power point socket from the socket cover.
Claw
H06012
2.
(a)
(b)
Trim
Body
(c)
INSTALL POWER POINT SOCKET ASSY RR
Assemble the power point socket to the power point socket cover at the position 10 mm (0.39 in.) away from full lock
position and ensure that they are temporarily locked.
Align the cut-out on the body with the claw on the power
point socket cover and install the power point socket and
cover to the body.
After installing them, push in the power point socket
approx. 10 mm (0.39 in.) to lock it.
Claw
Power Point Socket
H06013
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3550
67-29
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
CIGARETTE LIGHTER ASSY
CIGARETTE LIGHTER ASSY
67167-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
COMPONENTS: See page 67-2
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
2.
(a)
REMOVE CIGARETTE LIGHTER ASSY
Remove the cigarette lighter cover.
(b)
Disengage the meshing of the cigarette lighter and the
cigarette lighter indicator lens by rotating the cigarette
lighter assy.
Pull out the cigarette lighter assy.
E51929
(c)
E37339
3.
(a)
INSTALL CIGARETTE LIGHTER ASSY
Aligning the socket with the cutout of the socket cover, fully push it to install.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3548
67-33
AUDIO & VISUAL SYSTEM
-
WINDOW GLASS (ANTENNA WIRE)
WINDOW GLASS (ANTENNA WIRE)
6716B-01
REPAIR
Tester Probe
Heat Wire
Tin Foil
BE4029
1.
INSPECT WINDOW GLASS (ANTENNA WIRE)
NOTICE:
When cleaning the glass, use a soft, dry cloth, and wipe the
glass in the direction of the wire. Take care not to damage
the wires. Do not use detergents or glass cleaners with
abrasive ingredients. When measuring voltage, wind a
piece of tin foil around the top of the negative probe and
press the foil against the wire with your finger, as shown in
the illustration.
(a)
Inspect the continuity at the center of each antenna wire
as shown in the illustration.
2.
(a)
(c)
REPAIR WINDOW GLASS (ANTENNA WIRE)
Clean the broken wire tips with a grease, wax and silicone
remover.
Place the masking tape along both sides of the wire to be
repaired.
Throughly mix the repair agent (Dupont paste No. 4817).
(d)
(e)
(f)
Using a fine tip brush, apply a small amount to the wire.
After a few minutes, remove the masking tape.
Do not repair the defogger wire for at least 24 hours.
E32576
Repair Point
(b)
Broken
Wire
Masking Tape
BE0150
Fine Tip Brush
Repair Point
Glass
BE0151
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3552
69-2
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
-
HORN SYSTEM
6909D-01
INSPECTION
3
5
1
2
5
1
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT RELAY (HORN)
Remove the HORN relay from the engine room J/B.
Measure the HORN relay resistance.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
2
3
B60778
2.
(a)
INSPECT HIGH PITCHED HORN ASSY
Check operation of the horn.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Specified Operation
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Horn bracket
Horn sounds
If the result is not as specified, replace the horn assy.
B72265
3.
(a)
INSPECT LOW PITCHED HORN ASSY
Check operation of the horn.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Specified Operation
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Horn bracket
Horn sounds
If the result is not as specified, replace the horn assy.
B72265
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3554
69-1
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
-
HORN SYSTEM
HORN SYSTEM
6900G-04
LOCATION
High Pitched Horn
Low Pitched Horn
Steering Wheel Pad
Horn Button Switch
Engine Room J/B
HORN Relay
HORN Fuse
B74626
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3553
70-1
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
WINDSHIELD GLASS
WINDSHIELD GLASS
700AE-03
COMPONENTS
Assist Grip Assy
Roof Headlining Assy
Inner Rear View
Mirror Assy
Front Door Opening Trim
Weatherstrip RH
Inner Rear View
Mirror Cover
Roof Console Box
Cover Inner
RH Visor Assy
LH Visor Assy
Courtesy Lens
Assist Grip Assy
Windshield Moulding
Outer Upper
Visor Holder
Front Pillar Garnish RH
Windshield Moulding Outside RH
Windshield Glass Stopper No. 2
Windshield Glass Stopper No. 1
Windshield Glass Stopper No. 2
Window Glass Adhesive Dam No. 2
Window Glass Adhesive Dam
Windshield Outside Moulding Clip No. 1
Windshield Moulding Outside LH
Windshield Outside
Moulding Clip No. 1
Front Pillar Garnish LH
Windshield Glass
Cowl Top Ventilator
Louver
Hood to Cowl
Top Seal
Cowl Top Vent
Louver Protector
Front Door Opening Trim
Weatherstrip LH
Front Wiper Arm RH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
24 (245, 18)
Front Wiper Arm LH
B75810
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3555
70-2
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
WINDSHIELD GLASS
7012T-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP LH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE LH VISOR ASSY (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE RH VISOR ASSY (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE VISOR HOLDER (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE ROOF CONSOLE BOX ASSY (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE ASSIST GRIP ASSY (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSY (See page 76-21 )
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
HINT:
It is not necessary to completely remove the roof headlining. Slightly lower the front section of the roof headlining so that the windshield glass can be removed later in step 19.
11. REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY (See page 70-34 )
12. REMOVE FR WIPER ARM LH (See page 66-7 )
13. REMOVE FR WIPER ARM RH (See page 66-7 )
14. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER SUB-ASSY (See page 66-7 )
Screwdriver
Clip
Clip
Clip
Protective
Tape
B51773
15. REMOVE WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTSIDE LH
(a) Put protective tape.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the 5 clips.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Using a screwdriver, pry out the hooks and windshield
moulding outside LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
16. REMOVE WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTSIDE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3556
70-3
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
17.
(a)
5 mm
Protective Tape
Drill
Rivet
WINDSHIELD GLASS
REMOVE WINDSHIELD OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
NO.1
Using a drill of less than φ 4 mm (0.16 in.), gently and perpendicularly place the drill tip onto the rivet and cut the rivet flanges.
HINT:
Wind tape around the drill blade so that the drill blade appears
approximately 5 mm (0.20 in.) on the edge.
NOTICE:
Be sure to gently place the drill perpendicular to the
rivet to prevent the rivet hole and the drill itself from
being damaged.
Be careful as the cut rivet will be very hot.
(b) Even if the flange is taken off, continue drilling and push
cut the remaining fragment with the drill.
(c) Remove the windshield outside moulding clip No.1.
Protective Tape
B63756
Windshield Glass
Cut
18.
(a)
Moulding
Cut
Vehicle Body
B51745
REMOVE WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTER UPPER
Using a knife, cut off the moulding, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body with the knife.
(b) Remove the remaining moulding.
HINT:
Make a partial cut in the moulding. Then pull and remove it by
hand.
19.
(a)
(b)
Stopper
(c)
Piano Wire
REMOVE WINDSHIELD GLASS
w/ Window defogger:
Disconnect the connector.
From the interior, insert piano wire between the vehicle
body and glass, as shown in the illustration.
Tie objects that can serve as handles (for example, wooden blocks) to all wire ends.
B51747
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3557
70-4
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
Plastic Sheet
Protective Tape
B63724
WINDSHIELD GLASS
HINT:
Apply protective tape to the outer surface of the vehicle body
to prevent its surface from being scratched.
NOTICE:
When separating the glass from the vehicle, be careful not to damage the vehicle’s paint or interior/exterior ornaments.
To prevent the safety pad from being scratched when
removing the glass, place a plastic sheet between the
piano wire and safety pad.
(d) Cut through the adhesive by pulling the piano wire around
the glass.
(e) Disengage the stoppers.
(f)
Using a suction cup, remove the glass.
NOTICE:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body as possible
when removing the glass.
20.
(a)
B73128
Backside
Ceramic Line
A
B
C
C
Stopper
B75811
CLEAN WINDSHIELD GLASS
Using a scraper, remove the damaged stoppers, dams
and adhesive sticking to the glass.
(b) Clean the outer circumference of the glass with white gasoline.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the glass surface after cleaning it.
Even if using new glass, clean the glass with white
gasoline.
21. INSTALL WINDSHIELD GLASS STOPPER NO.2
(a) Coat the installation part of the stoppers with Primer G.
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Throw away any leftover Primer G.
Do not apply too much Primer G.
(b) Install 2 new stoppers onto the glass, as shown in the illustration.
Specification:
Area
Measurement
A
7.1 mm (0.28 in.)
B
40 mm (1.58 in.)
C
12.5 mm (0.49 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3558
70-5
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
22.
(a)
Stopper
WINDSHIELD GLASS
INSTALL WINDSHIELD GLASS STOPPER NO.1
Install 2 new stoppers to the vehicle body, as shown in the
illustration.
Vehicle Body
B63758
Backside
A
A
A
A
A
A
B
A - A
23.
(a)
Dam No. 2
Dam
B - B
B
a
INSTALL WINDOW GLASS ADHESIVE DAM
Coat the installation part of the windshield glass adhesive
dam with Primer G.
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Throw away any leftover Primer G.
Do not apply too much Primer G.
(b) Install a new dam, applying double-sided tape all the way
around the glass except where the stoppers are installed,
as shown in the illustration.
Specification:
b
B51766
Adhesive
Measurement
a
7 mm (0.28 in.)
b
37 mm (1.46 in.)
24.
25.
(a)
Adhesive
Vehicle Body
Area
B73084
INSTALL WINDOW GLASS ADHESIVE DAM NO.2
INSTALL WINDSHIELD GLASS
Clean and shape the contact surface of the vehicle body.
(1) Using a knife, cut away any rough adhesive on the
contact surface of the vehicle body to ensure the
appropriate surface shape.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
HINT:
Leave as much of the adhesive on the vehicle body as possible.
(2) Clean the contact surface of the vehicle body with
a piece of shop rag saturated with cleaner.
HINT:
Even if all the adhesive has been removed, clean the vehicle
body.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3559
70-6
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
WINDSHIELD GLASS
(b)
Mark
B73132
Position the glass.
(1) Using a suction cup, place the glass in the correct
position.
(2) Check that the whole contact surface of the glass
rim is perfectly even.
(3) Place reference marks between the glass and vehicle body.
NOTICE:
Check that the stoppers are attached to the vehicle body
correctly.
HINT:
When reusing the glass, check and correct the reference mark
positions.
(4) Using a suction cup, remove the glass.
(c)
Primer M
Primer M
Adhesive
B76576
Using a brush, coat the exposed part of the vehicle body
with Primer M.
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Do not coat the adhesive with Primer M.
Throw away any leftover Primer M.
Do not apply too much Primer M.
(d) Using a brush or sponge, coat the edge of the glass and
the contact surface with Primer G.
HINT:
If the area other than that specified is coated by accident, wipe
off the primer with a clean shop rag before it dries
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Throw away any leftover Primer G.
Do not apply too much Primer G.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3560
70-7
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
(e)
B
A
A
A
Apply adhesive.
Adhesive: Part No. 08850-00801 or equivalent
(1) Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle, as shown in
the illustration.
HINT:
After cutting off the tip, use all adhesive within the time described in the table below.
Usage timeframe:
B
B
WINDSHIELD GLASS
Temperature
B51767
Usage Timeframe
35C (95F)
15 minutes
20C (68F)
1 hour 40 minutes
5C (41F)
8 hours
(2)
(3)
Load the sealer gun with the cartridge.
Coat the glass with adhesive, as shown in the illustration.
Specification:
Area
Measurement
A
8 mm (0.31 in.)
B
12 mm (0.47 in.)
(f)
Mark
B73132
Install the glass.
(1) Using a suction cup, position the glass so that the
reference marks are aligned. Press it in gently along
the rim.
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Check that the stoppers are attached to the vehicle
body correctly.
Check that the vehicle body and glass have a small
gap between them.
(2) Lightly press the front surface of the glass to ensure
that the glass is securely fit to the vehicle body.
(3)
Using a scraper, remove any excess or protruding
adhesive.
HINT:
Apply adhesive on the glass rim.
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle for the amount of time described
in the table below.
Minimum time:
Adhesive
B73131
Temperature
Minimum time prior to driving vehicle
35°C (95°F)
1 hour 30 minutes
20°C (68°F)
5 hours
5°C (41°F)
24 hours
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3561
70-8
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
26.
(a)
27.
(a)
(b)
WINDSHIELD GLASS
INSTALL WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTER UPPER
Place a new moulding onto the vehicle body and tap it by hand.
CHECK FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
Conduct a leak test after the adhesive has completely hardened.
Seal any leaks with auto glass sealer.
28. INSTALL WINDSHIELD OUTSIDE MOULDING CLIP
NO.1
Protective
(a) Using an air riveter or hand riveter with nose piece, strike
Tape
rivets into the body panel to install the windshield outside
moulding clip No. 1 to the body panel.
NOTICE:
If the rivet is not positioned perpendicularly, it will
bend the mandrel.
When trigger is then pulled, it may damage the rivet’s
mandrel.
B63761
Riveter
INCORRECT
NOTICE:
Do not prize a riveter, because the riveter will be damaged and the mandrel will be bent.
Mandrel
B76594
Riveter
INCORRECT
Riveter
INCORRECT
Do not tilt the riveter when removing the rivet, because the materials are not tightened firmly.
B76595
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3562
70-9
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
Riveter
WINDSHIELD GLASS
Install the rivet while attaching the materials, because they are not tightened firmly.
INCORRECT
B76596
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3563
70-17
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
BACK DOOR GLASS
BACK DOOR GLASS
700AF-03
COMPONENTS
w/ Rear Spoiler:
Rear Spoiler
Back Window Panel Trim Upper
Spacer
Back Door Glass
Back Window Moulding Outside
Back Door Trim Cover RH
Spacer
Back Door Trim Cover LH
Rear Wiper Arm Assy
6.0 (61, 53 in.⋅lbf)
Back Door Trim Panel Assy
Assist Strap Hole Cover
Assist Strap Assy RH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B74624
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3571
70-18
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
BACK DOOR GLASS
7012W-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
REMOVE ASSIST STRAP HOLE COVER (See page 75-20 )
REMOVE ASSIST STRAP ASSY RH (See page 75-20 )
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM PANEL ASSY (See page 75-20 )
REMOVE BACK WINDOW PANEL TRIM UPPER (See page 75-20 )
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM COVER RH (See page 75-20 )
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM COVER LH (See page 75-20 )
REMOVE REAR WIPER ARM ASSY (See page 66-12 )
REMOVE REAR SPOILER (W/ REAR SPOILER) (See page 76-8 )
9.
(a)
(b)
Piano Wire
(c)
Spacer
REMOVE BACK DOOR GLASS
Disconnect the connector.
From the interior, insert piano wires between the vehicle
body and glass, as shown in the illustration.
Tie objects that can serve as handles (for example, wooden blocks) to all wire ends.
Spacer
B76598
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3572
70-19
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
Protective Tape
B65166
BACK DOOR GLASS
HINT:
Apply protective tape to the outer surface of the vehicle body
to prevent its surface from being scratched.
NOTICE:
When separating the glass from the vehicle, be careful not to damage the vehicle’s paint or interior/exterior ornaments.
To prevent the safety pad from being scratched when
removing the glass, place a plastic sheet between the
piano wire and safety pad.
(d) Cut through the adhesive by pulling the piano wire around
the glass.
(e) Using a suction cup, remove the glass.
NOTICE:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body as possible
when removing the glass.
10.
(a)
B73128
CLEAN BACK DOOR GLASS
Using a scraper, remove the damaged spacers, moulding
and adhesive sticking to the glass.
(b) Clean the outer circumference of the glass with white gasoline.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the glass surface after cleaning it.
Even if using new glass, clean the glass with white
gasoline.
B76577
11. INSTALL BACK DOOR GLASS SPACER NO.1
(a) Coat the installation part of the spacers with Primer G.
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Throw away any leftover Primer G.
Do not apply too much Primer G.
(b) Install 2 new spacers onto the glass, as shown in the illustration.
12. INSTALL BACK WINDOW GLASS SPACER NO.2
Backside
Spacer
Ceramic Line
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3573
70-20
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
BACK DOOR GLASS
13.
(a)
INSTALL BACK WINDOW MOULDING OUTSIDE
Coat the installation part of the back window moulding
outside with Primer G.
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Throw away any leftover Primer G.
Do not apply too much Primer G.
(b) Install a new back window moulding outside, as shown in
the illustration.
Specification:
Center
A
Moulding
a
Area
Measurement
a
2 mm (0.08 in.)
Moulding End
Glass
Adhesive
B51738
14.
(a)
Adhesive
Vehicle Body
B73084
INSTALL BACK DOOR GLASS
Clean and shape the contact surface of the vehicle body.
(1) Using a knife, cut away any rough adhesive on the
contact surface of the vehicle body to ensure the
appropriate surface shape.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
HINT:
Leave as much of the adhesive on vehicle body as possible.
(2) Clean the contact surface of the vehicle body with
a piece of shop rag saturated with cleaner.
HINT:
Even if all the adhesive has been removed, clean the vehicle
body.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3574
70-21
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
BACK DOOR GLASS
(b)
Primer M
Primer M
Adhesive
(d)
B76576
Using a brush, coat the exposed part of the vehicle body
with Primer M.
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Do not coat the adhesive with Primer M.
Throw away any leftover Primer M.
Do not apply too much Primer M.
(c) Using a brush or sponge, coat the edge of the glass and
the contact surface with Primer G.
HINT:
If the area other than that specified is coated by accident, wipe
off the primer with a clean shop rag before it dries
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Throw away any leftover Primer G.
Do not apply too much Primer G.
Apply adhesive.
Adhesive: Part No. 08850-00801 or equivalent
Backside
c
c
a
a
A
A-A
C-C
A
B
B
D
C
B-B
b
b
c
D
a
C
D-D
b
a
b
B74625
(1)
Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle, as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
After cutting off the tip, use all adhesive within the time described in the table below.
Usage timeframe:
Temperature
Usage Timeframe
35C (95F)
15 minutes
20C (68F)
1 hour 40 minutes
5C (41F)
8 hours
(2) Load the sealer gun with the cartridge.
(3) Coat the glass with adhesive, as shown in the illustration.
Specification:
Area
Measurement
a
12 mm (0.47 in.)
b
8 mm (0.31 in.)
c
12 mm (0.47 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3575
70-22
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
BACK DOOR GLASS
(e)
Install the back window glass to the vehicle body.
(1) Hold the back window glass in place securely with protective tape or equivalent until the adhesive
hardens.
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Check that the spacers are attached to the vehicle body correctly.
Check that the vehicle body and glass have a small gap between them.
(2) Lightly press the front surface of the glass to ensure that the glass is securely fit to the vehicle
body.
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle for the amount of time described in the table below.
Minimum time:
Temperature
Minimum time prior
to driving vehicle
35°C (95°F)
1 hour 30 minutes
20°C (68°F)
5 hours
5°C (41°F)
24 hours
(3)
Hold the glass in place securely with a protective
tape or equivalent until the adhesive hardens.
B51457
15.
(a)
(b)
CHECK FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
Conduct a leak test after the adhesive has completely hardened.
Seal any leaks with auto glass sealer.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3576
70-25
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
7002R-03
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH
ASSY
Check continuity.
(1) Check the continuity between the terminals when
battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 8.
B31305
Standard:
Switch operation
Measurement condition
Specified condition
UP
Battery positive - Terminal 8
Battery negative - Terminal 1
Continuity between terminals 3 - 7
Continuity between terminals 1 - 6
DOWN
Battery positive - Terminal 8
Battery negative - Terminal 1
Continuity between terminals 1 - 3
Continuity between terminals 6 - 7
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3579
70-23
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
7002Q-03
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT POWER WINDOW
NOTICE:
The initial condition that the customizing function is not chosen by the hand-held tester is shown.
(a) Check the basic function (Manual operation function).
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) Check that the door glass move up when the power window regulator master switch is pulled UP
halfway and moves down when the switch is pushed DOWN halfway.
(3) Check that the door glass moves up when the power window regulator switch of each door is
pulled UP, and moves down when the switch is pushed DOWN.
(4) Check that the door glasses other than the driver side door glass do not operate when the window lock switch is turned to LOCK.
(b) Check the automatic operation function (Only driver side door glass).
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) Check that the AUTO UP function operates to fully close the door glass when the power window
regulator master switch is pulled UP fully.
(3) Check that the AUTO DOWN function operates to fully open the door glass when the power window regulator master switch is pushed DOWN fully.
(4) Check that the door glass will stops when the applicable window switch is pulled UP during the
AUTO DOWN operation side, (However, if the UP and DOWN operations are continued, it will
change is pushed to manual operation).
(5) Check that the door glass stop when the applicable window switch change is pushed DOWN during AUTO UP operation (However, if the UP and DOWN operations are continued, it will change
is pushed to manual operation).
(c) Check the operation function after key-off.
(1) After turning the ignition switch from ON to OFF, check that each door glass can be operated via
the power window regulator master switch. Also, check that operation is disabled after the driver
door is opened then closed once.
(2) After turning the ignition switch from ON to OFF, check that the power window regulator master
switch is unable to operate the door glass approximately 45 seconds later.
(3) After turning the ignition switch from ON to OFF with the driver side door open, check that AUTO
UP or AUTO DOWN function keeps operating until the door is fully open or fully closed even when
the door is closed in the middle of the middle of operation. Also check that power window operation is disabled after operation has ended.
(d) Check the operation function by driver side door key operation (Operation interlocked with key).
(1) Check that the driver side door glass moves down when the door lock cylinder is held in the UNLOCK position for 2 seconds or more by key operation. Also, check that the door glass stops
when the door lock cylinder is turned back to the original position.
(2) Check that the driver side door glass moves up when the door lock cylinder is held in the LOCK
position for 2 seconds or more by key operation. Also, check that the door glass stops when the
door lock cylinder is turned back to the original position.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3577
70-24
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
(e) Check the jam protection function (Only driver side door glass).
NOTICE:
Do not check this function using a part of your body such as a hand. Also, pay thorough attention that nothing gets caught by accident in this process.
If the power window regulator motor assembly has just been reset, raise and lower the door
glass several times using AUTO operation before preforming check.
HINT:
The jam protection function works during the following UP operations; AUTO UP, UP after key-OFF, AUTO
UP after key-OFF, UP interlocked with key.
(1)
(2)
Hammer Handle
(3)
B51853
Fully open the door glass.
Insert the handle of the hammer when the door
glass is almost in the fully closed position.
Try to fully close the door glass with AUTO UP operation, and check that the door glass moves down
about 200 mm (7.87 in.) and stops there, so that
hammer handle is not caught.
HINT:
The window goes down by about 50 mm or for 1 second. However, when the opening between the glass and body is less than
200 mm, the door glass goes down by 200 mm or keeps going
down for 5 seconds, and then stops.
(4) During DOWN operation, check that the door glass
does not move up even when the applicable window switch is pulled UP.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3578
70-28
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
70025-04
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
Left/Right Adjustment Switch
Mirror
Switch
10
INSPECT OUTER MIRROR SWITCH ASSY
Inspect the mirror switch continuity.
(1) Turn to the left/right adjustment switch to the L position.
Inspect the left side mirror switch continuity.
Tester connection
Switch position
Specified condition
-
OFF
No continuity
4⇔8
6⇔7
UP
Continuity
4⇔7
6⇔8
DOWN
Continuity
5⇔8
6⇔7
LEFT
Continuity
5⇔7
6⇔8
RIGHT
Continuity
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
(2) Turn to the left/right adjustment switch to the R position.
Inspect the right side mirror switch continuity.
1
B50553
Tester connection
Switch position
Specified condition
-
OFF
No continuity
3⇔8
6⇔7
UP
Continuity
3⇔7
6⇔8
DOWN
Continuity
2⇔8
6⇔7
LEFT
Continuity
2⇔7
6⇔8
RIGHT
Continuity
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3582
70-29
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
2.
(a)
B64823
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY RH
Inspect operation of the mirror motor.
Battery connection
Mirror operation
Positive (+) - 6
Negative (-) - 5
Upward
Positive (+) - 5
Negative (-) - 6
Downward
Positive (+) - 4
Negative (-) - 5
Left
Positive (+) - 5
Negative (-) - 4
Right
(b)
Check operation of the mirror heater.
(1) Check the mirror between terminals 7 and 8 of the
connector.
Standard: continuity
(2) Check that the mirror is warmed up when connecting the battery positive (+) to terminal 7 and the battery negative (-) to terminal 8 of the connector.
3.
(a)
INSPECT OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY LH
Inspect operation of the mirror motor.
B64823
(b)
Battery connection
Mirror position
Positive (+) - 6
Negative (-) - 5
Turn upward
Positive (+) - 5
Negative (-) - 6
Turn downward
Positive (+) - 4
Negative (-) - 5
Turn left
Positive (+) - 5
Negative (-) - 4
Turn right
Check operation of the mirror heater.
(1) Check the mirror between terminals 7 and 8 of the
connector.
Standard: continuity
(2) Check that the mirror is warmed up when connecting the battery positive (+) to terminal 7 and the battery negative (-) to terminal 8 of the connector.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3583
70-26
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
70023-04
LOCATION
Outer Rear View Mirror Assembly RH
Outer Rear View Mirror Assembly LH
Outer Mirror Switch Assembly
B51419
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3580
70-27
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
70024-04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspected Area
Mirror does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Mirror operates abnormally.
1. Mirror switch
2. Mirror motor
3. Wire harness
See Page
CIG fuse (I/P J/B)
Mirror switch
Mirror motor
Wire harness
70-28
70-28
70-28
70-28
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3581
70-32
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
7019F-01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT DEFOGGER RELAY
Inspect the defogger relay (Marking: DEF) continuity.
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1-2
3-4
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3-5
Continuity
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
B50610
2.
INSPECT AIR CONDITONER CONTROL ASSY (SEE PAGE 55-7 )
Defogger Wire
Tester Probe
Tin Foil
B66134
3.
INSPECT BACK WINDOW (DEFOGGER WIRE)
NOTICE:
When cleaning the glass, wipe the glass along the
wire using a soft and dry cloth. Take care not to damage the wires.
Do not use detergents or glass cleaners including
abrasive ingredients.
When measuring voltage, wrap a piece of tin foil
around the tip of the negative tester probe and press
the foil against the wire with your finger, as shown in
the illustration.
(a)
(b)
(c)
At Center
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Turn the defogger switch ON.
Check the voltage at the center of each defogger wire, as
shown in the illustration.
Standard:
Voltage
Criteria
Approx. 5 V
Okay, wire is not broken
Approx. 10 V or 0 V
Wire is broken
B63720
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3586
70-33
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
Foil Strip
0V
Less than
10 V
Broken
Wire
V
Ground Side
Battery
Side
B63721
HINT:
If there is approx 10 V, the wire may be broken between the center of the wire and the end on the battery side. If there is no voltage, the wire may be broken between the center of the wire and
the end on the ground side.
(d) Place the voltmeter positive (+) lead against the defogger
wire on the battery side.
(e) Place the voltmeter negative (-) lead with the foil strip
against the wire on the ground side.
(f)
Slide the positive (+) lead from the battery side to the
ground side.
(g) The point where the voltmeter deflects from approx 10 V
to 0 V is the place where the defogger wire is broken.
HINT:
If the defogger wire is not broken, the voltmeter indicates 0 V
at the positive (+) end of the defogger wire but gradually increases to approx 12 V as the meter probe moves to the other
end.
(h)
Repair Point
Masking Tape
Broken
Wire
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
If necessary, repair the defogger wire.
(1) Clean the broken wire tips with grease, wax and silicone remover.
(2) Place the masking tape along both sides of the wire.
(3) Thoroughly mix the repair agent (Dupont paste No.
4817).
B63722
(4)
Using a fine tip brush, apply a small amount of the
agent to the wire.
After a few minutes, remove the masking tape.
(5)
NOTICE:
Do not repair the defogger wire again for at least 24 hours.
B63723
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3587
70-30
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
7002G-06
LOCATION
Defogger Wire (w/ TV Antenna)
Rear Window Defogger Switch
Defogger Wire
Network GateWay Computer
(w/ EMV)
Air Conditioner Amplifier Assembly
(w/ EMV)
Air Conditioner Amplifier Assembly
(w/o EMV)
B51618
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3584
70-31
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
7002F-07
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspected Area
See Page
Rear window defogger does not operate
(Indicator lamp On)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Communication Function
RR DEF 30 A Fuse
Defogger Relay
Rear Window Defogger Wire
Wire Harness
A/C ECU
70-32
05-1123
Rear window defogger does not operate
(Indicator lamp OFF)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Heater 15A Fuse
A/C Control Panel
Defogger Switch(A/C Panel Switch)
A/C ECU
Wire Harness
Gateway Computer
05-1114
05-1114
05-1123
05-1123
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3585
70-10
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
QUARTER WINDOW ASSY LH
QUARTER WINDOW ASSY LH
7012U-01
COMPONENTS
w/ Rear No. 2 Seat
Rear Floor
Finish Plate
Deck Board Sub-assy No. 2
w/ Tonneau Cover:
Tonneau Cover
Deck Side Trim
Box RH
Deck Board Sub-assy
Deck Board Bracket
Reinforcement
Deck Board Sub-assy No. 3
Deck Side Trim
Box LH
Rear No. 2 Seat Assy
37 (377, 27)
Deck Floor Box Rear
Rear Combination Lamp
Service Cover LH
42, (428, 31)
Rear No. 2 Seat Belt
Assy Outer LH
Roof Side Garnish
Assy Inner
Roof Side Rail
Garnish Sub-assy
Quarter Pillar
Garnish LH
Rear Seat Track
Cover LH
Spacer
Quarter Window
Assy LH
Rear Side Trim
Cover LH
Rear Door Opening Trim
Weatherstrip LH
Deck Side Trim
Cover FR
42, (428, 31)
Rear Door Scuff Plate LH
Deck Side Trim
Cover FR
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Rear No. 1 Seat Belt
Assy Outer LH
Rope Hook
Deck Trim Side Panel
Assy LH
B74622
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3564
70-1 1
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
QUARTER WINDOW ASSY LH
w/o Rear No. 2 Seat
Deck Board Sub-assy No. 2
Rear Floor
Finish Plate
w/ Tonneau Cover:
Tonneau Cover
Deck Board Sub-assy
Deck Side Trim
Box RH
Deck Board Sub-assy No. 3
Deck Floor Box Rear
Deck Floor Box Front
Deck Side Trim
Box LH
Rear No. 1 Seat Assy
Quarter Window
Assy LH
37 (377, 27)
Rear Combination Lamp
Service Cover LH
Roof Side Rail
Garnish Sub-assy
Quarter Pillar
Garnish LH
Spacer
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer
Roof Side Garnish
Assy Inner
Rear Side Trim
Cover LH
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Inner
42, (428, 31)
Rear Door Opening Trim
Weatherstrip LH
Rear Door Scuff Plate LH
Deck Side Trim
Cover FR
Rear No. 1 Seat Belt
Assy Outer LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Deck Trim Side Panel
Assy LH
Rope Hook
B74623
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3565
70-12
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
QUARTER WINDOW ASSY LH
7012V-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
REMOVE REAR NO. 1 SEAT ASSY (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT) (See page 72-28 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP LH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER ASSY (W/ TONNEAU COVER) (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY NO.2 (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY NO.3 (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX REAR (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM BOX LH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM BOX RH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX FRONT (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT) (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR FLOOR FINISH PLATE (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD BRACKET REINFORCEMENT (W/ REAR NO.2 SEAT)
(See page 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SEAT ASSY (W/ REAR NO.2 SEAT) (See page 72-61 )
REMOVE REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT ASSY OUTER LH (See page 61-15 )
REMOVE REAR NO.2 SEAT BELT ASSY OUTER LH (W/ REAR NO.2 SEAT) (See page 61-22 )
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM COVER LH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LAMP SERVICE COVER LH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE ROPE HOOK (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK COVER LH (W/ REAR NO.2 SEAT) (See page 72-44 )
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSY LH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE QUARTER PILLAR GARNISH LH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE ROOF SIDE RAIL GARNISH SUB-ASSY LH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSY INNER LH (See page 76-21 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3566
70-13
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
25.
(a)
A
A
B
B
D
D
C
A -A
C
B-B
QUARTER WINDOW ASSY LH
REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW ASSY LH
Using a knife, cut off the moulding, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body with the knife.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
(c) Remove the remaining moulding.
HINT:
Make a partial cut in the moulding. Then, pull and remove it by
hand.
C -C
D -D
B51739
(d)
Retainer
(e)
Piano
Wire
From the interior, insert piano wires between the vehicle
body and glass, as shown in the illustration.
Tie object that can serve as handles (for example, wooden blocks) to all wire ends.
HINT:
Apply protective tape to the outer surface of the vehicle body
to prevent its surface from being scratched.
NOTICE:
When separating the glass from the vehicle, be careful not
to damage the vehicle’s paint or interior/exterior ornaments.
(f)
Cut through the adhesive by pulling the piano wire around
the glass.
(g) Using a suction cup, remove the glass.
NOTICE:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body as possible
when removing the glass.
Spacer
Spacer
Spacer
Spacer
Retainer
B76597
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3567
70-14
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
26.
(a)
(b)
QUARTER WINDOW ASSY LH
INSTALL QUARTER WINDOW GLASS SPACER
Clean the installation area.
Install new spacers onto the glass.
27.
(a)
Adhesive
Adhesive
Vehicle Body
B73084
INSTALL QUARTER WINDOW ASSY LH
Clean and shape the contact surface of the vehicle body.
(1) Using a knife, cut away any rough adhesive on the
contact surface of the vehicle body to ensure the
appropriate surface shape.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
HINT:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body as possible.
(2) Clean the contact surface of the vehicle body with
a piece of shop rag saturated with cleaner.
HINT:
Even if all the adhesive has been removed, clean the vehicle
body.
(b)
Primer M
Primer M
Adhesive
B76576
Using a brush, coat the exposed part of the vehicle body
on the vehicle side with Primer M.
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Do not coat the adhesive with Primer M.
Throw away any leftover Primer M.
Do not apply too much Primer M.
(c) Using brush or sponge, coat the edge of the glass and the
contact surface with Primer G.
HINT:
If an area other than that specified is coated by accident, wipe
off the primer with a clean shop rag before it dries.
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Throw away any leftover Primer G.
Do not apply too much Primer G.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3568
70-15
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
(d)
QUARTER WINDOW ASSY LH
Apply adhesive.
Adhesive: Part No. 08850-00801 or equivalent
Backside
A -A
Marking
C-C
a
a
A
B -B
B
b
b
A
B
d
c
D
D
C
D -D
a
a
b
C
e
a
b
b
B78004
(1)
Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle, as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
After cutting off the tip, use all adhesive within the time described in the table below.
Usage timeframe:
Temperature
Usage Timeframe
35C (95F)
15 minutes
20C (68F)
1 hour 40 minutes
5C (41F)
8 hours
(2) Load the sealer gun with the cartridge.
(3) Coat the glass with adhesive, as shown in the illustration.
Specification:
Area
Measurement
a
8 mm (0.31 in.)
b
6 mm (0.24 in.)
c
5 mm (0.20 in.)
d
2 mm (0.08 in.)
e
4 mm (0.16 in.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3569
70-16
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
QUARTER WINDOW ASSY LH
(e)
Install the quarter window to the vehicle body.
(1) Hold the quarter window in place securely with protective tape or equivalent until the adhesive
hardens.
NOTICE:
Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes or more.
Check that the spacers are attached to the vehicle body correctly.
Check that the vehicle body and glass have a small gap between them.
(2) Lightly press the front surface of the glass to ensure that the glass is securely fit to the vehicle
body.
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle for the amount of time described in the table below.
Minimum time:
28.
(a)
(b)
Temperature
Minimum time prior
to driving vehicle
35°C (95°F)
1 hour 30 minutes
20C (68F)
5 hours
5°C (41°F)
24 hours
CHECK FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
Conduct a leak test after the adhesive has completely hardened.
Seal any leaks with auto glass sealer.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3570
70-37
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY
7012Z-01
INSPECTION
HINT:
EC mirror stands for electrochromic mirror.
1.
6
7
Battery
w/ EC mirror:
INSPECT INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY
(a) Inspect operation of the electrochromic inner rear view
mirror.
(1) Connect the battery’s positive (+) lead to terminal 6
and the battery’s negative (-) lead to terminal 7.
(2) Attach black colored tape to the forward sensor to
prevent it from sensing.
(3) Light up the mirror with an electric light, and check
that the mirror surface changes from bright to dark.
If the result is not as specified, replace the mirror assy.
Black Colored Tape
Forward Sensor
Bright
Dark
B57086
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3591
70-35
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY
7012Y-01
PRE-CHECK
1.
(a)
2.
(a)
3.
(a)
4.
(a)
5.
SELECT COMPASS DISPLAY MODE
The COMP switch allows you to select the ”Display” or ”Non-display” mode of the compass.
SET ZONE
The location of magnetic north and true north differs depending on the location. Adjustment of the compass’s magnetism is required to correct possible compass deviations from true north. Each user must
set a zone (refer to the Compass Zone Map). This will automatically adjust the compass to the magnetic conditions in the zone selected.
The zone setting can be changed using the inner rear view mirror COMP switch.
PERFORM CALIBRATION
Because each vehicle has its own magnetic field, calibration should be performed for each vehicle.
This compass function is used when storing information about the vehicle’s magnetic field.
WHEN COMPASS IS MAGNETIZED:
A compass may become magnetized during shipping by vessels or freight cars. Make sure to perform
calibration and ensure that calibration is performed properly before delivery. If calibration cannot be
completed despite driving the vehicle in a circle several times, the vehicle’s magnetic field may be interfering with the calibration. Demagnetize the vehicle using a demagnetizer and perform calibration
again.
SET COMPASS
COMP Switch
On Duration
Normal Mode
Ignition switch ON
Pressed
Compass Non-display Mode
Pressed for 3 seconds
6. Zone Setting Mode
Pressed for 6 seconds
COMP Switch ON
Zone area +1
7. Calibration Mode
Leaving it untouched
for a while
Normal Mode
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3589
70-36
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
6.
(a)
INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY
ZONE SETTING MODE
Pressing the COMP switch for 3 seconds in the normal mode will activate the zone setting mode.
A number (1 to 15) is displayed on the compass display.
HINT:
In the initial state, ”8” is displayed.
(b) The displayed number increases by 1 every time the COMP switch is pressed. Referring to the map,
check the number for the area where the vehicle will be used and set the zone number.
(c) Do not touch the compass for several seconds after setting the zone. Check that the compass display
shows an azimuthal direction (N, NE, E, SE, S, SW, W, or NW) or ”C”.
7.
CALIBRATION SETTING MODE
(a) Pressing the COMP switch for 6 seconds in the normal mode will activate the calibration setting mode.
(b) Drive the vehicle at 8 km/h (5 mph) or less in a circle.
(c) Driving in a circle 1 to 3 times will display the azimuthal direction on the display, completing the calibration.
HINT:
After the calibration is completed, it is not necessary to perform the above procedures unless the magnetic
field strength of the vehicle drastically changes. If this happens, the azimuthal display will change to ”C”.
B77945
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3590
70-34
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS/MIRROR -
INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY
INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY
7012X-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order.
EC mirror stands for electrochromic mirror.
1.
(a)
(b)
(a)
Cover
w/o EC mirror:
REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY
Push the cover in the direction indicated by the arrows (a)
and remove it.
While holding down the claw in the direction of the block
arrow (b), slide the inner rear view mirror assy in the direction of the while arrow (c) and remove it.
(a)
Claw
(b)
(c)
B64964
2.
Slide
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
w/ EC mirror:
REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY
Remove the mirror cover.
Disconnect the connector.
Using a torx socket wrench (T20), remove the screw.
Slide the mirror in the direction indicated by the arrow in
the illustration, and remove the mirror.
B77943
3.
Slide
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
w/ EC mirror and compass:
REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY
Remove the mirror cover.
Disconnect the connector.
Using a torx socket wrench (T20), remove the screw.
Slide the mirror in the direction indicated by the arrow in
the illustration, and remove the mirror.
B77942
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3588
71-3
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
COMBINATION METER
710LK-02
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT SPEEDOMETER
Check the operation.
(1) Using a speedometer tester, inspect the speedometer for acceptable indication error and check
the operation of the odometer.
Reference: km/h (Canada)
Standard indication
Acceptable range
20 km/h
18.0 to 23.0 km/h
40 km/h
40.0 to 44.0 km/h
60 km/h
60.0 to 64.5 km/h
80 km/h
80.0 to 85.0 km/h
100 km/h
100.0 to 105.0 km/h
120 km/h
120.0 to 125.5 km/h
140 km/h
140.0 to 146.0 km/h
160 km/h
160.0 to 167.0 km/h
180 km/h
180.0 to 188.0 km/h
200 km/h
200.0 to 209.0 km/h
Reference: mph (U.S.)
Standard indication
Acceptable range
20 MPH
20.0 to 23.0 MPH
40 MPH
40.0 to 43.5 MPH
60 MPH
60.0 to 64.0 MPH
80 MPH
80.0 to 84.5 MPH
100 MPH
100.0 to 105.0 MPH
120 MPH
120.0 to 125.5 MPH
NOTICE:
Tire wear and over or under tire pressure will affect the indication error.
(2) Check the deflection width of the speedmeter indicator.
Reference: Below 0.5 km/h (0.3 mph)
2.
(a)
Wire Harness View:
C12-13
I30440
INSPECT OUTPUT SIGNAL OF VEHICLE SPEED
Check the output signal waveform.
(1) Remove the combination meter assy.
(2) Connect the oscilloscope to the terminals C12-13
and body ground.
(3) Start the engine.
(4) Check the signal waveform according to the condition (s) in the table below.
Item
Condition
Tool setting
5 V/DIV, 20 ms/DIV
Vehicle condition
Driving at approx. 20Km/h
HINT:
As the vehicle speed increases, the cycle of the signal waveform narrows.
GND
A05135
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3594
71-4
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
COMBINATION METER
3.
(a)
INSPECT TACHOMETER
Check operation
(1) Connect the tune-up test tachometer and start the engine.
NOTICE:
Reversing the connection of the tachometer will damage the transistors and the insides of the
diodes.
When removing or installing the tachometer, be careful not to drop or subject it to heavy
shocks.
(2) Compare the result of the test with the standard indication.
DC 13.5 V, 25C (77F)
Acceptable range (r/min)
Data in ( ) are for reference
Standard indication (r/min)
700
630 to 770
1,000
(900 to 1100)
2,000
(1850 to 2150)
3,000
2800 to 3200
4,000
(3800 to 4200)
5,000
4800 to 5200
6,000
(5750 to 6250)
7,000
6700 to 7300
4.
(a)
(b)
Fuel Sender Gauge Connector
Front View:
(c)
I30899
(d)
(e)
5.
(a)
(b)
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSPECT FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE
Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
Connect terminals 1 and 2 on the wire harness side connector of the fuel sender gauge.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, then check the
position of the receiver gauge needle.
OK:
Needle position is on (EMPTY).
Connect terminals 2 and 3 on the wire harness side connector of the fuel sender gauge.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, then check the
position of the receiver gauge needle.
OK:
Needle position is on (FULL).
INSPECT FUEL LEVEL WARNING
Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position, then check that the fuel level needle indicates EMPTY and
the fuel level warning light comes on.
OK:
Fuel level warning light comes on.
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the low oil pressure switch.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
Ground the terminal of the wire harness side connector, then check the low oil pressure warning light.
OK:
Low oil pressure warning light comes on.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3595
71-5
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
COMBINATION METER
7.
(a)
INSPECT BRAKE WARNING LIGHT
Inspect the parking brake warning light.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the parking brake switch.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Ground the terminal of the wire harness side connector, then check the parking brake warning
light.
OK:
Brake warning light comes on.
(b) Inspect the brake fluid level warning light.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the brake fluid level warning switch.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(3) Connect a terminal to the other terminal of the wire harness side connector, then check the brake
fluid level warning switch.
OK:
Brake warning light comes on.
8.
INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(a) Remove the reservoir tank cap and strainer.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard:
Float up (switch off): 10 kΩ or higher
(d) Use a syphon, etc. to take fluid out of the reservoir tank.
(e) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard:
Float down (switch on): Below 1 Ω
(f)
Pour the fluid back in the reservoir tank.
9.
INSPECT WASHER LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the connector from the washer level warning switch.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(c) Ground the terminal of the wire harness side connector, then check the washer level warning light.
OK:
Washer level warning light comes on.
10. MAINTENANCE LIQUID RESETTING PROCEDURE
Indicator Condition:
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
HINT:
State
Condition
Specified State
Blinking
The vehicle runs 4,500 miles after the previous
setting
The indicator blinks for 15 seconds after the ignition switch on (including 3 seconds for a valve
check).
Continuously Illuminated
The vehicle runs 5,000 miles after the previous
setting
The indicator is continuously illuminated after the
ignition switch on.
Set the display window to ODO.
Turn the ignition switch off.
Pressing the reset switch, turn the ignition switch to the ON position (keep pressing for at least 5 seconds).
Reset procedure is completed.
If the ignition switch is turned off during reset procedure, reset mode is canceled.
If the reset switch is turned off during the reset procedure, reset mode is canceled and the display
shows the condition prior to the reset procedure.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3596
71-1
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
COMBINATION METER
COMBINATION METER
7101E-06
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Warning Lights:
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
7. ECM
Check Engine warning light does not come on.
05-5
05-366
71-18
8. Wire Harness or Connector
9. Combination Meter Assy
1. ECM
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-5
05-366
71-18
Brake warning light does not come on.
1. Skid control ECU
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-761
71-18
ABS warning light does not come on.
1. ABS ECU
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-761
71-18
SRS warning light does not come on.
1. Airbag Sensor Assy Center
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-1200
71-18
Open Door warning light does not come on.
1. Refer to troubleshooting
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-1601
71-18
Fuel Level warning light does not come on.
1. Refer to troubleshooting
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-1893
71-18
Low Oil Pressure warning light does not come on.
1. Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. Combination Meter Assy
Driver’s seat belt warning light does not come on.
1. Refer to troubleshooting
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-1898
71-18
1. Low Oil Level Sensor
4. Combination Meter Assy
05-5
05-366
05-5
05-366
71-18
1. Wire Harness or Connector
2. Skid Control ECU
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-761
71-18
Discharge warning light does not come on.
”OIL LEVEL” warning light does not come on.
”TIRE AIR PRESS” warning light does not come on.
71-3
71-18
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. ECM
Indicator Lights:
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Turn indicator light does not come on.
1. Turn Signal and Hazard Warning System
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-1533
71-18
High Beam indicator light does not come on.
1. Headlight Dimmer Switch
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-1533
71-18
Washer level indicator light does not come on.
1. Washer Level Warning Switch
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. Combination Meter Assy
Author:
71-18
Date:
3592
71-2
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
COMBINATION METER
MAINT REQD indicator ia blinking or cotinuously illuminated.
1. Resetting procedure
2. Combination Meter Assy
71-3
71-18
All buzzer (key reminder, tail cancel, Seat belt) does not operate.
1. Refer to troubleshooting
2. Combination Meter Assy
05-1879
71-18
O/D OFF indicator light does not come on.
1. O/D off Select Switch
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. Combination Meter Assy
71-18
SLIP indicator light does not come on.
1. Wire Harness or Connector
2. Skid Control ECU
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-761
71-18
VSC indicator light does not come on.
1. Wire Harness or Connector
2. Skid Control ECU
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-761
71-18
TRC/TRAC OFF indicator light does not come on.
1. Wire Harness or Connector
2. Skid Control ECU
3. Combination Meter Assy
05-761
71-18
1. Wire Harness or Connector
2. Automatic transmission
05-883
05-993
71-18
A/T OIL TEMP indicator light does not come on.
3. Combination Meter Assy
ECT SNOW indicator light does not come on.
1. Wire Harness or Connector
2. ECM
05-5
05-366
71-18
3. Combination Meter Assy
1. Park Neutral Position Switch
A/T shift indicator light does not come on.
05-883
05-993
05-5
05-366
71-18
2. Wire Harness or Connector
3. ECM
4. Combination Meter Assy
”CRUISE” indicator light does not come on.
1. Wire Harness or Connector
2. ECM
05-5
05-366
71-18
3. Combination Meter Assy
Meter Gauges:
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Speedometer does not operate.
1. Refer to troubleshooting
05-1885
Tachometer does not operate.
1. Refer to troubleshooting
05-1889
Fuel Gauge does not operate or operates abnormally.
1. Refer to troubleshooting
05-1893
Water temperature does not operate.
1. Refer to troubleshooting
05-1896
Clock:
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
1. Power source or ground
05-1170
05-1173
05-1175
71-6
Clock will not operate
Clock loses or gains time
2. Integration control & panel assy
Author:
Date:
3593
71-9
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY
7101I-02
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
PRECAUTION FOR VEHICLE WITH SRS AIRBAG AND SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
Some operations in this section may affect the SRS airbags. Prior to performing the corresponding
operations, read the SRS airbag NOTICE (see page 60-1 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3600
71-10
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY
710LI-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
COMPONENTS: SEE PAGE 71-6
1.
TABLE OF BOLT, SCREW AND NUT
HINT:
The bolts, screws and nuts necessary for installation and removal of the instrument panel, are illustrated
below and alphabetically coded.
mm (in.) (L = Length)
Code
Shape
Code
φ=5
(0.20)
L = 16
(0.63)
φ=6
(0.24)
L = 25
(0.98)
φ=8
(0.32)
L = 20
(0.79)
φ=5
(0.20)
L = 18.5
(0.73)
Shape
Code
φ = 5.22
(0.21)
L = 16
(0.63)
Shape
φ=6
(0.24)
L = 16
(0.63)
φ=6
(0.24)
L = 20
(0.79)
φ=6
(0.24)
L = 20
(0.79)
φ=6
(0.24)
L = 20
(0.79)
φ=6
(0.24)
φ=6
(0.24)
L = 18
(0.71)
φ=6
(0.24)
L = 16
(0.63)
B78418
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.2
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.3
REMOVE HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3601
71-1 1
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSY (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010, 09953-05020, 09954-05021)
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER LWR (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER UPR (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
REMOVE HEADLAMP DIMMER SWITCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 65-25 )
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSY (SEE PAGE 66-16 )
12.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSY CENTER
Using a moulding remover, disengage the 8 clips.
Disconnect the connectors, then remove the instrument
cluster finish panel sub-assy center.
HINT:
Set the shift lever in the N position.
8 Clips
13.
14.
B51309
REMOVE INTEGRATION CONTROL & PANEL ASSY (W/O NAVIGATION SYSTEM)
(SEE PAGE 55-26 )
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLA Y (CRT DISPLAY) DISPLAY (W/ NAVIGATION SYSTEM)
(SEE PAGE 67-8 )
15.
(a)
(b)
5 Clips
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER
Using a moulding remover, disengage the 5 clips.
Disconnect the connectors, then remove the instrument
panel finish panel lower.
B51316
16.
(a)
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
ASSY
Using a moulding remover, disengage the 5 clips, then remove the instrument cluster finish panel assy.
5 Clips
B51317
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3602
71-12
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
17.
(a)
(b)
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
GARNISH
Remove the 4 screws .
Disengage the claw, then remove the instrument cluster
finish panel garnish.
B51318
18.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE COMBINATION METER ASSY
Remove the 3 screws , then pull the combination meter assy.
Disconnect the connectors, then remove the combination
meter assy.
B51319
19.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
3 Clips
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSY LOWER
Remove the 2 bolts .
Disengage the 3 clips.
Disconnect the connectors.
Disconnect the hood lock control cable, then remove the
instrument panel finish panel sub-assy lower.
B51321
20.
(a)
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PNL INSERT SUB- ASSY
LWR LH
Remove the 3 bolts and the instrument panel insert
sub-assy LWR LH.
B75540
21.
(a)
(b)
2 Claws
4 Clips
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
ASSY CENTER
Using a moulding remover, disengage the 4 clips and the
2 claws.
Disconnect the connectors, then remove the instrument
cluster finish panel assy center.
HINT:
Set the shift lever in the N position.
B75537
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3603
71-13
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
22.
(a)
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER LH
Remove the 2 clips and the floor carpet cover center LH.
B77066
23.
REMOVE FLOOR CARPET COVER CENTER RH
Claw
24.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ARMREST ASSY CENTER
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the seat armrest cover LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip, before use.
(b) Remove the bolt and front seat armrest assy center.
B76439
25.
(a)
Protective Tape
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX ASSY
Cover the parts indicated in the illustration with protective
tape to prevent them from being damaged.
(b) Remove the 3 screws .
(c) Remove the 2 console caps and the 2 screws .
(d) Remove the 2 bolts .
(e) Pull the console box assy towards the rear of the vehicle
and disengage the 2 clips, and then remove the console
box assy.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the bottom of the instrument panel safety pad when removing the console box assy.
2 Clips
B78445
26.
(a)
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSY
Remove the glove compartment door damper clip.
B51994
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3604
71-14
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY
(b)
Remove the 2 clips and the glove compartment door assy.
27.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER NO.2
Remove the 7 screws and the instrument panel finish
panel lower No. 2.
B51312
(a)
B51322
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
DISCONNECT PASSENGER AIRBAG CONNECTOR (SEE PAGE 60-29 )
REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM SUB-ASSY LH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM SUB-ASSY RH (SEE PAGE 76-21 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3605
71-15
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
35.
(a)
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY W/PASSENGER AIR BAG ASSY
Disconnect the connectors.
B51328
(b)
(c)
Remove the 7 bolts and the nut .
Disengage the 3 pins, then remove the instrument panel safety pad sub-assy.
B51323
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3606
71-16
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY
36. REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL GARNISH NO.2
(a) Disengage the 4 clips, then remove the instrument cluster finish panel garnish No. 2.
37. REMOVE AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the automatic light control sensor.
38. REMOVE COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) THERMISTOR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the cooler (solar sensor) thermistor.
NOTICE:
Do not pry the cooler (solar sensor) thermistor off from the upper position.
39. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL PIN NO.1
(a) Remove the 3 screws and the 3 instrument panel pin No.1.
40. REMOVE DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSY
(a) Remove the 7 screws and the defroster nozzle assy.
41. REMOVE SIDE DEFROSTER NOZZLE DUCT NO.1
(a) Remove the screw and the defroster nozzle duct No. 1.
42. REMOVE SIDE DEFROSTER NOZZLE DUCT NO.2
(a) Remove the screw and the side defroster nozzle duct No. 2.
43. REMOVE HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT NO.1
(a) Remove the clip.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and the heater to register duct No. 1.
44. REMOVE HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT NO.4
(a) Remove the clip.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and the heater to register duct No. 4.
45. REMOVE HEATER TO REGISTER CENTER SUB DUCT
(a) Remove the 4 screws and the heater to register center sub duct.
46. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER ASSY LOWER NO.1
(a) Remove the 2 screws and the instrument panel register assy lower No. 1.
47. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER ASSY NO.1
(a) Remove the 2 screws and the instrument panel register assy No. 1.
48. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACKET SUB-ASSY CENTER
(a) Remove the 3 screws and the instrument panel bracket sub-assy center.
49. REMOVE NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSY (W/ NAVIGATION SYSTEM) (SEE PAGE 67-19 )
50. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
51. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL PASSENGER AIR BAG ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-29 )
52. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3607
71-17
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
53.
54.
(a)
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL PASSENGER AIR BAG ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-29 )
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD SUB-ASSY W/PASSENGER AIR BAG ASSY
Install the 7 bolts , nut with the instrument panel safety pad sub-assy.
Torque:
Bolt : 20 N⋅m (204 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
B51323
55.
56.
57.
58.
59.
60.
61.
62.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ARMREST ASSY CENTER
CENTER SPIRAL CABLE (SEE PAGE 60-26 )
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSY (SEE PAGE 50-8 )
INSPECT STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
INSTALL HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-1 1)
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3608
71-18
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
COMBINATION METER ASSY
COMBINATION METER ASSY
7101K-05
OVERHAUL
HINT:
The installation is in the reverse order of the removal. However, when there is a special point concerning
the installation, it is indicated.
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSY CENTER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
3.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
4.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL GARNISH (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
5.
REMOVE COMBINATION METER ASSY (SEE PAGE 71-10 )
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE COMBINATION METER GLASS
Remove the 2 screws.
Disengage the 6 claws and remove the combination meter glass.
6 Claws
B78425
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3609
71-6
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
7101H-02
COMPONENTS
Front Pillar Garnish LH
Front Pillar Garnish RH
C
C
I
C
20 (204, 15)
E
G
G
G
G
G
G
G
G
G
G
G
Instrument Cluster
Finish Panel Garnish
Combination Meter Assy
B
B
B
B
G
B
G
G
G
G
Instrument Panel Finish
Panel Lower No.2
w/o Navigation System:
Integration Control & Panel Assy
w/ Navigation System:
Multi-Display (CRT Display)
Display
G
E
G
C
B
B
B
B
B
B
G
Instrument Cluster
Finish Panel
Sub-assy Center
Steering Column
Windshield Wiper
Cover UPR
B
Switch Assy
Glove Compartment
Door Assy
Cowl Side Trim
Sub-assy RH
Front Door
Scuff Plate RH
B
B
Instrument Panel Finish
Panel Lower
Instrument Panel
Insert Sub-assy
LWR LH
Instrument Cluster
Finish Panel Assy
Headlamp Dimmer
Switch Assy
Steering Column
Cover LWR
Steering Wheel
F
Cover Lower No.3
F
Steering Wheel
Cover Lower No.2
50 (510, 37)
F
B
D
Floor Carpet Cover Floor Carpet Cover
Center RH
Center LH
B
K
K
Instrument Panel Finish Panel
Sub-assy Lower
Console Box Assy
Front Door
Scuff Plate LH
B
J
D
Cowl Side Trim
Sub-assy LH
Horn Button Assy
Instrument Cluster
Finish Panel Assy Center
8.8 (90, 78 in.⋅lbf)
J
Front Seat Armrest Assy
37 (378, 27)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
Front Seat Armrest Cover
: Specified torque
B75538
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3597
71-7
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
Instrument Panel Pin No.1
Instrument Panel Wire
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
Instrument Panel Passenger Airbag Assy
w/ Navigation System:
Navigation Antenna
5.6 (57, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Instrument Panel Safety
Pad Sub-assy
A
Cooler Thermistor
A
Automatic Light
Control Sensor
Instrument Panel
Register Assy No.1
A
A
A
Instrument Panel
Register Assy
Lower No.1
A
A
Instrument
Cluster Finish
Panel Garnish No.2
A
A
A
A
Defroster Nozzle Duct No.2
A
A
A
A
Defroster Nozzle Assy
A
Defroster Nozzle
Duct No.1
A
A
Heater To Register
Instrument Finish
Duct No.4
Panel Retainer
Lower No.2
A
A
A
A
A
Heater To Register
Center Sub Duct
Heater To Register Duct No.1
Instrument Finish Panel
Retainer Lower No.1
A
A
A
I
Instrument Panel
Bracket Sub-assy
Center
I
L
L
Instrument Panel Finish Panel Retainer Lower No.3
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
B75539
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3598
71-8
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
-
INSTRUMENT PANEL/METER
Instrument Cluster
Finish Panel Garnish
Instrument Cluster Finish
Sub-assy Center
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
Glass
Instrument Cluster Finish
Panel Assy
Instrument Panel
Finish Panel Lower
B51335
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3599
61-3
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
FRONT SEAT BELT
610JU-01
COMPONENTS
Front Door Opening Trim Weatherstrip RH
Rear Door Opening trim Weatherstrip RH
42 (428, 31)
Shoulder Anchor Cover
Rear Door Scuff Plate RH
42 (428, 31)
Center Pillar Garnish Lower RH
7.5 (77, 66 in. ⋅lbf)
42 (428, 31)
Front Door Scuff Plate RH
Floor Anchor Cover
Manual Seat Type
Power Seat Type
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy RH
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy RH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
B77526
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3457
61-8
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
610JW-01
DISPOSAL
HINT:
When scrapping vehicles equipped with a seat belt pretensioner or disposing of a front seat outer belt (with
seat belt pretensioner), always first activate the seat belt pretensioner in accordance with the procedures
described below. If any abnormality occurs during activation of the seat belt pretensioner, contact the SERVICE DEPARTMENT of TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC. When disposing of a front seat outer belt
assy (with seat belt pretensioner) that was activated in a collision, start with step 1-(f) in this section.
SST
B50515
CAUTION:
Never dispose of a front seat outer belt assy that has
an inactivated pretensioner.
The seat belt pretensioner produces a loud, exploding sound when it activates. Perform the operation
where it will not be a nuisance to nearby residents.
When activating a front seat outer belt (with seat belt
pretensioner), stand at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the
front seat outer belt.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
seat belt with an activated pretensioner.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
activation.
Do not apply water to a front seat outer belt that has
an activated pretensioner
When activating the seat belt pretensioner, always
use the specified SST (SRS airbag deployment tool).
Perform operation in a place away from electrical interference.
SST 09082-00700
1.
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
(WHEN INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
HINT:
Prepare a battery to power activation of the seat belt pretensioner.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3462
61-9
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
(a) Check if SST is functioning.
CAUTION:
When activating the seat belt pretensioner, always use the
specified SST.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00770
SST
B50515
(1)
Connect SST red clip to the battery’s positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the negative (-) terminal.
HINT:
Do not connect the yellow connector. The yellow connector is
used to connect to the seat belt pretensioner.
Battery
SST
B50511
(2)
SST
B50514
Press SST activation switch and check that the LED
of SST activation switch turn on.
CAUTION:
If the LED turns on when the activation switch is not being
pressed, SST may be malfunctioning. Do not use SST.
(b) Disconnect SST from the battery.
(c) Disconnect the pretensioner connector.
(1) Disconnect the battery’s negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check the SRS airbag system (see page 60-53 ).
(3) Remove the front door scuff plate RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(4) Remove the rear door scuff plate RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(5) Remove the front door opening trim weatherstrip
RH (see page 76-21 ).
(6) Remove the rear door opening trim weatherstrip RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(7) Remove the center pillar garnish lower RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(8) Remove the center pillar garnish upper RH
(see page 76-21 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3463
61-10
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
(9)
(d)
Disconnect the pretensioner connector, as shown
in the illustration.
Connect SST.
(1) Install the floor anchor of the seat belt.
B61489
B60414
(2)
SST
Connect 2 SSTs, then connect the yellow connector
to the seat belt pretensioner.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00770
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging SST connector and wire harness, do
not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
SST
B51763
(3)
(4)
10 m or more
B50513
Move SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the front
of the vehicle.
Close all the doors and windows of the vehicle.
HINT:
Do not close the windows fully. Leave a gap for inserting SST
wire harness.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage SST wire harness.
(5) Connect SST red clip to the battery’s positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the negative (-) terminal.
(e) Activate the seat belt pretensioner.
(1) Confirm that no one is inside the vehicle or within 10
m (33 ft) of the vehicle.
(2) Press SST activation switch and activate the seat
belt pretensioner.
HINT:
The seat belt pretensioner operates simultaneously with the
LED light for SST activation switch.
(f)
Dispose of the outer belt (with the seat belt pretensioner).
CAUTION:
Do not touch the outer belt for at least 30 minutes after
the seat belt pretensioner has been activated. It is
very hot.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling an outer belt with a pretensioner that has been activated.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water to a front seat outer belt that has
an activated pretensioner
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3464
61-1 1
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle, activate the seat belt pretensioner,
and then scrap the vehicle with the activated outer belt
installed.
2.
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
(WHEN NOT INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
When disposing of the front seat outer belt (with the
seat belt pretensioner) only, never use the customer’s vehicle to activate the seat belt pretensioner.
Be sure to follow the procedures listed below when
activating the seat belt pretensioner.
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to activate the seat belt
pretensioner.
(a)
Cut Here
B79201
Remove the outer belt (see page 61-4 ).
(1) Wind the seat belt with the retractor.
(2) When the seat belt is sufficiently wound, cut the
seat belt approximately 10 cm from the retractor, as
shown in the illustration
HINT:
The seat belt is designed so that winding the seat belt as much
as possible before pretensioner activation will decrease the
pulling power of the seat belt during pretensioner activation.
(b) Check if SST is functioning (see step 1-(a)).
CAUTION:
When activating the seat belt pretensioner, always use the
specified SST.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00770
Battery
SST
B50511
(c)
SST
Connect SST.
(1) Connect SST, then connect them to the seat belt
pretensioner.
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging SST connector and wire harness, do
not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
SST
B51763
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3465
61-12
SEAT BELT
(2)
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
Place the outer belt on the ground and cover it with
a tire with a wheel attached.
NOTICE:
Set up the front seat outer belt assy as shown in the illustration.
SST
SST
B69491
(3)
10 m or More
B50541
Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the
wheel.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire harness.
(d) Activate the seat belt pretensioner.
(1) Connect SST red clip to the battery’s positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the battery’s negative (-)
terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within 10 m (33 ft) of the wheel.
(3) Press SST activation switch and activate the seat
belt pretensioner.
HINT:
The seat belt pretensioner operates simultaneously with the
LED light for SST activation switch.
(e) Dispose of the outer belt (with the seat belt pretensioner).
CAUTION:
Do not touch the outer belt for at least 30 minutes after
the seat belt pretensioner has been activated. It is
very hot.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling an outer belt assy with a pretensioner that has been activated.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
operation.
Do not apply water to an outer belt assy that has an
activated pretensioner.
(1) Remove the wheel and SST.
(2)
Place the outer belt in a plastic bag, tie the end tightly and dispose of it in the same way as other general
parts.
B60422
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3466
61-4
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
610JV-03
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the RH side.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
Manual seat type:
REMOVE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY RH
CAUTION:
Removal of the seat belt pretensioner must be started
at least 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned
OFF and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
Carefully read the notices for the ”pretensioner” in
the SRS airbag system section and the front seat outer belt section (see page 60-1 ).
(a) Remove the front seat RH (see page 72-1 1).
(b) Remove the front seat cushion shield inner RH
(see page 72-1 1).
(c) Remove the front seat inner belt RH.
(1) Disconnect the connector and clamp.
(2) Remove the nut and belt.
(d)
Protruding Part
B78495
Install the front seat inner belt RH.
(1) Install the belt with the nut.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not allow the anchor part of the front belt and the protruding part of the floor panel to overlap.
(e) Connect the clamp and connector.
(f)
Connect the battery’s negative battery terminal.
(g) Initialize the occupant classification sensor
(see page 72-1 1 or 72-19 ).
(h) Check the SRS warning lamp (see page 60-1 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3458
61-5
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
2.
Power seat type:
REMOVE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY RH
CAUTION:
Removal of the seat belt pretensioner must be started
at least 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned
OFF and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
Carefully read the notices for the ”pretensioner” in
the SRS airbag system section and the front seat outer belt section (see page 60-1 ).
(a) Remove the front seat assy RH (see page 72-1 1).
(b) Remove the power seat switch knobs
(see page 72-1 1).
(c) Disconnect the connector and clamp.
(d) Remove the nut and belt.
(e)
Protruding Part
B77530
Install the belt with the nut.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not allow the anchor part of the front belt and the protruding part of the floor panel to overlap.
(f)
Connect the clamp and connector.
(g) Connect the battery’s negative battery terminal.
(h) Initialize the occupant classification sensor
(see page 72-1 1 or 72-19 ).
(i)
Check the SRS warning lamp (see page 60-1 ).
3.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
CAUTION:
Removal of the seat belt pretensioner must be started
at least 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned
OFF and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
Carefully read the notices for the ”pretensioner” in
the SRS airbag system section and the front seat outer belt section (see page 60-1 ).
(a) Remove the front door scuff plate RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(b) Remove the rear door scuff plate RH (see page 76-21 ).
(c) Remove the front door opening trim weatherstrip
(see page 76-21 ).
(d) Remove the rear door opening trim weatherstrip
(see page 76-21 ).
(e) Remove the center pillar garnish lower RH
(see page 76-21 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3459
61-6
SEAT BELT
(f)
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
Remove the front seat outer belt assy RH.
(1) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove the shoulder belt anchor cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(2) Remove the bolt and shoulder anchor.
Claw
Protective
Tape
B78496
(3)
Claw
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove the floor belt anchor cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B77537
(4)
(5)
B61489
B60414
Unlock
(g)
45
Lock
B60413
Disconnect the pretensioner connector, as shown
in the illustration.
Remove the 2 bolts and outer belt.
B61488
Install the front seat outer belt assy RH.
(1) Check the amount of inclination required to lock the
retractor.
When the inclination of the retractor is 15 or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from
the retractor. When the inclination of the retractor is over 45, check that the belt locks.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
If operation is not as specified, replace the outer belt assy.
(2) Install the front seat outer belt assy RH.
Torque:
7.5 N⋅m (77 kgf⋅cm, 66 in.⋅lbf) for upper bolt
42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf) for lower bolt
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3460
61-7
SEAT BELT
-
FRONT SEAT BELT
(3)
(h)
(i)
B78597
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
(n)
(o)
(p)
Connect the pretensioner connector, as shown in
the illustration.
(4) Install the shoulder belt anchor to the shoulder belt
anchor adjuster with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
Install the center pillar garnish lower.
Install the floor anchor to the front seat with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
Install the front door scuff plate.
Install the rear door scuff plate.
Install the front door opening trim weatherstrip.
Install the rear door opening trim weatherstrip.
Connect the battery’s negative battery terminal.
Initialize the occupant classification sensor
(see page 72-1 1 or 72-19 ).
Check the SRS warning lamp (see page 60-1 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3461
61-13
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
610JX-01
COMPONENTS
7.5 (77, 66 in. ⋅lbf)
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Inner Belt Assy LH
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
Rear No. 1 Seat Outer Belt Assy RH
Rear Seat Inner Belt Assy RH
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Inner Belt Assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
B78506
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3467
61-14
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
Rear Door Opening Trim Weatherstrip RH
Quarter Pillar Garnish RH
Tonneau Cover
Back Door Weather Strip
Deck Trim Side Panel RH
Deck Board No. 2
Rope Hook
Rear Floor Finish
Plate
Deck Board Cover
Rear Door Scuff Plate RH
Deck Board No. 3
Deck Side Trim Box RH
Deck Floor Box RR
Deck Floor Box FR
Deck Side Trim Box LH
w/ Rear No. 2 Seat
Deck Trim
Foot Air Duct
Deck Board
Rear Seat Reclining Cover RH
Rear Door Scuff Plate RH
Rear Floor Silencer
Floor Carpet
B78297
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3468
61-15
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
610JY-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the RH side.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSY RH
w/o Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the deck board (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear No.1 seat RH (see page 72-35 or 72-54 ).
Remove the rear seat belt assy inner RH.
(1) Remove the bolt and belt.
Install the rear seat belt assy inner RH.
(1) Install the belt with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
REMOVE REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY CENTER
w/o Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the deck board (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear No. 1 seat RH (see page 72-35 or 72-54 ).
Remove the rear seatback cover (see page 72-35 or 72-54 ).
Remove the rear seat outer belt assy center.
(1) Remove the nut, bolt and belt.
(e)
Unlock
45
Lock
B77535
Install the rear seat outer belt assy center.
(1) Check the degree of tilt when the belt begins to lock
the ELR.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
When the inclination of the retractor is 15 or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from
the retractor. When the inclination of the inclination of the retractor is over 45 check that
the belt locks.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt assy.
(2) Install the seat belt with bolt and nut.
Torque:
7.5 N⋅m (77 kgf⋅cm, 66 in.⋅lbf) for bolt
42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf) for nut
(3) Install the seatback cover
(see page 72-35 or 72-54 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3469
61-16
SEAT BELT
Protruding Part
B76375
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
(4) Install the floor anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not allow the anchor part of the rear belt and the protruding parts of the seat cushion frame to overlap.
With the belt installed, check that the belt
locks when it is pulled out quickly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat belt assy.
(5) Check the ELR lock.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the assembly
installed.
With the belt installed, check that the belt
locks when it is pulled out quickly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt assy.
3.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSY
w/o Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the deck board (see page 76-21 ).
(b) Remove the rear No. 1 seat LH
(see page 72-35 or 72-54 ).
(c) Remove the rear seat inner belt assy.
(1) Remove the bolt and belt.
(d) Install the rear seat inner belt assy.
(1) Install the belt with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not allow the anchor part of the rear belt and the protruding parts of the floor panel to overlap.
Protruding Part
Protruding Part
B77533
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSY LH
w/o Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the deck board (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear No.1 seat LH
(see page 72-35 or 72-54 ).
Remove the rear seat inner belt assy LH.
(1) Remove the bolt and belt.
Install the rear seat inner belt assy LH.
(1) Install the belt with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3470
61-17
SEAT BELT
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
(n)
(o)
(p)
(q)
(r)
(s)
(t)
(u)
(v)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
REMOVE REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
Remove the tonneau cover (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck board cover (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck board cover No. 2 (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck board cover No. 3 (see page 76-21 ).
w/ Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the rear seat reclining cover RH
(see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck floor box RR (see page 76-21 ).
w/o Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the deck floor box FR (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear floor finish plate (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck side trim box LH (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck side trim box RH (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear No. 1 seat LH (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear No. 1 seat RH (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear door scuff plate RH
(see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear door opening trim weatherstrip RH
(see page 76-21 ).
Remove the back door weatherstrip (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rope hook (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck trim side panel RH
(see page 76-21 ).
w/ Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the quarter pillar garnish RH
(see page 76-21 ).
w/ Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the 3 clips and turn over the front floor carpet.
w/ Rear No. 2 seat:
Remove the 2 clips and rear floor silencer LH and RH.
w/ Rear A/C:
Remove the 4 clips and foot air duct rear.
Remove the rear seat outer belt assy RH.
(1) Remove the bolt and shoulder anchor.
(2) Remove the bolt and belt.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3471
61-18
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
(w)
Unlock
45
Lock
B77535
Install the rear seat outer belt assy RH.
(1) Check the degree of tilt when the belt begins to lock
the ELR.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
When the inclination of the retractor is 15 or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from
the retractor. When the inclination of the inclination of the retractor is over 45 check that
the belt locks.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt assy.
(2)
Claw
Claw
Install the belt assy with the bolt, as shown in the illustration.
B78498
Protruding Part
Front Side
Floor Anchor
B78499
(3) Install the rear outer belt with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not allow the anchor part of the rear belt and the protruding parts of the floor panel to overlap.
With the belt installed, check that the belt
locks when it is pulled out quickly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat belt assy.
(4) Check the ELR lock.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer belt assy
installed.
With the belt installed, check that the belt
locks when it is pulled out quickly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3472
61-19
SEAT BELT
-
(5)
REAR NO.1 SEAT BELT
Check the fastening function of the child restraint
system.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer belt assy
installed.
When the belt is pulled out fully, the belt
should automatically try to retract.
After the belt has fully retracted, the belt
should be able to be pulled out and retracted
again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the belt assy.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3473
61-20
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT BELT
REAR NO.2 SEAT BELT
610JZ-01
COMPONENTS
42 (428, 31)
Rear No. 2 Seat Outer Belt Assy RH
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
7.5 (77, 66 in. ⋅lbf)
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Lap Type Belt Assy RH
Rear Seat Inner Belt Assy
Rear Seat Lap Type Belt Assy LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
B77529
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3474
61-21
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT BELT
Rear Door Opening Trim Weatherstrip RH
Deck Trim Side Cover
Deck Trim Side Panel RH
Rear Seat Reclining Cover RH
Rear Door Scuff Plate RH
Tonneau Cover
Back Door Weatherstrip
Deck Board No. 2
Deck Board Cover
Rear Floor Finish Plate
Deck Board No. 3
Rear Floor Box RR
Rear Floor Trim Box RH
Deck Floor Box FR
Deck Side Trim Box LH
B78296
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3475
61-22
SEAT BELT
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT BELT
610K0-02
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
2.
(a)
(b)
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the RH side.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
REMOVE REAR SEAT LAP TYPE BELT RH
Remove the rear No. 2 seat (see page 72-61 ).
Remove the rear seat lap type belt assy RH.
(1) Remove the bolt and belt.
Install the rear seat lap type belt assy RH.
(1) Remove the bolt and belt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSY
Remove the rear No. 2 seat (see page 72-61 ).
Remove the rear seat inner belt assy.
(1) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 belts.
(c)
Protruding Part
B77531
Install the rear seat inner belt assy.
(1) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 belts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not allow the anchor part of the rear belt and the protruding parts of the floor panel to overlap.
3.
REMOVE REAR NO.2 SEAT OUTER BELT ASSY RH
(a) Remove the tonneau cover (see page 76-21 ).
(b) Remove the deck board cover (see page 76-21 ).
(c) Remove the deck board cover No. 2 (see page 76-21 ).
(d) Remove the deck board cover No. 3 (see page 76-21 ).
(e) Remove the rear seat reclining cover LH
(see page 76-21 ).
(f)
Remove the rear seat reclining cover RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(g) Remove the deck floor box RR (see page 76-21 ).
(h) Remove the rear floor finish plate (see page 76-21 ).
(i)
Remove the deck side trim box LH (see page 76-21 ).
(j)
Remove the deck side trim box RH (see page 76-21 ).
(k) Remove the rear No. 1 seat LH (see page 76-21 ).
(l)
Remove the rear No. 1 seat RH (see page 76-21 ).
(m) Remove the rear No. 2 seat RH (see page 76-21 ).
(n) Remove the rear door opening trim weatherstrip RH
(see page 76-21 ).
(o) Remove the back door weatherstrip (see page 76-21 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3476
61-23
SEAT BELT
(p)
(q)
(r)
(s)
Seat Belt Anchor Cover
(t)
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT BELT
Remove the rope hook (see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear door scuff plate RH
(see page 76-21 ).
Remove the deck trim side panel RH
(see page 76-21 ).
Remove the quarter pillar garnish RH
(see page 76-21 ).
Remove the rear No. 2 seat belt assy outer RH.
(1) Using a screwdriver, open the seat belt anchor cover
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(2) Remove the bolt and shoulder anchor.
(3) Remove the 2 bolts and belt.
Protective
Tape
Claw
B77538
(u)
Unlock
45
Lock
B77534
Install the rear No. 2 seat belt assy outer RH.
(1) Check the amount of inclination required to lock the
retractor.
When the inclination of the retractor is 15 or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from
the retractor. When the inclination of the retractor is over 45, check that the belt locks.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
If operation is not as specified, replace the outer belt assy.
(2) Install the belt with the 2 bolts.
Torque:
7.5 N⋅m (77 kgf⋅cm, 66 in.⋅lbf) for upper bolt
42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf) for lower bolt
(3) Install the shoulder anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3477
61-1
SEAT BELT
-
SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
610JS-01
LOCATION
Passenger Seat
Occupant Classification Sensor Rear
Occupant Classification Sensor Front
A/C Control Assy
Passenger Side Seat Belt Warning Lamp
Combination Meter Assy
Driver Side Seat Belt Warning Lamp
Occupant Classification ECU
Instrument Panel J/B
AM1 M-fuse
IG1 Fuse
RAD NO. 2 Fuse
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy RH
Airbag Sensor Assy
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy LH
B79063
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3455
61-2
SEAT BELT
-
SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
610JT-01
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspected Area
See Page
Driver side seat belt warning lamp does not flash
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
IG1 fuse
AM1 M-fuse
RAD NO. 2 fuse
Combination meter
Front seat inner belt assy LH
Airbag sensor assy
Wire harness
61-1
61-1
61-1
05-1898
05-1228
05-1228
Passenger side seat belt warning lamp does not flash
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
IG1 fuse
AM1 M-fuse
RAD NO. 2 fuse
A/C control assy
Front seat inner belt assy RH
Occupant classification sensor
Occupant classification ECU
Wire harness
61-1
61-1
61-1
05-1228
05-1228
05-1228
05-1228
NOTICE:
The front seat inner belt RH and LH cannot be inspected. When the front seat inner belt seems to be
malfunctioning, use the hand-held tester to check for DTCs.
HINT:
The seat belt warning system is part of the large-scale multiplex communication system. This system features shared communication wiring that reduces the wiring complexity of the communication lines. The first
step in any repair is to confirm the proper operation of the communication system. Proceed with troubleshooting after the communication has been verified (see multiplex communication system).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3456
72-6
SEAT
-
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
720RG-01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
Front Power Seat Switch LH
Driver’s seat only:
Front Vertical Switch
Reclining Switch
Slide Switch
Driver’s seat only:
Rear Vertical Switch
B60011
INSPECT FRONT POWER SEAT SWITCH LH
Check the resistance between the terminals when each
switch is operated.
Standard:
Slide switch
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-9
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
4-6
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
4-6
OFF
Below 1 Ω
4-9
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1-6
REAR
Below 1 Ω
4-9
REAR
Below 1 Ω
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 - 10
UP
Below 1 Ω
4 -5
UP
Below 1 Ω
4 -5
OFF
Below 1 Ω
4 - 10
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 -5
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
4 - 10
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-7
UP
Below 1 Ω
4 -8
UP
Below 1 Ω
4-7
OFF
Below 1 Ω
4 -8
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 -8
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
4 -7
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 -3
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
2 -4
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
2-4
OFF
Below 1 Ω
3 -4
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 -2
REAR
Below 1 Ω
3 -4
REAR
Below 1 Ω
Driver’s seat only:
Front vertical switch
Driver’s seat only:
Rear vertical switch
Reclining switch
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3615
72-7
SEAT
2.
(a)
Front Power Seat Switch RH
Reclining Switch
Slide Switch
-
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT FRONT POWER SEAT SWITCH RH
Check the resistance between the terminals when each
switch is operated.
Standard:
Slide switch
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-9
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
4-6
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
4-6
OFF
Below 1 Ω
4-9
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1-6
REAR
Below 1 Ω
4-9
REAR
Below 1 Ω
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 -3
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
Reclining switch
B68207
2 -4
FRONT
Below 1 Ω
2-4
OFF
Below 1 Ω
3 -4
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 -2
REAR
Below 1 Ω
3 -4
REAR
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch.
3.
Power Seat Switch Assy
(Lumbar Support)
(a)
Hold
Release
Driver’s seat only:
INSPECT POWER SEAT SWITCH ASSY
(LUMBAR SUPPORT)
Check the resistance between the terminals when the
switch is operated.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 -2
HOLD
Below 1 Ω
3 -4
HOLD
Below 1 Ω
1 -2
OFF
Below 1 Ω
4 -5
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 -3
RELEASE
Below 1 Ω
4 -5
RELEASE
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch assy.
B68208
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3616
72-8
SEAT
4.
(a)
Slide Motor
Counterclockwise
Clockwise
21
B35140
Driving Axis
B57292
-
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT FRONT SEAT ADJUSTER ASSY
Check operation of the slide motor.
(1) Check if the motor rotates smoothly when the battery is connected to the slide motor connector terminals.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the slide motor.
(b)
Front Vertical
Motor
Counterclockwise
Clockwise
21
B35140
Driving Axis
B57292
Driver’s seat only:
Check operation of the front vertical motor.
(1) Check if the motor rotates smoothly when the battery is connected to the front vertical motor connector terminals.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the front vertical motor.
(c)
Rear Vertical
Motor
Counterclockwise
B35140
Clockwise
21
Driving Axis
B57292
Driver’s seat only:
Check operation of the rear vertical motor.
(1) Check if the motor rotates smoothly when the battery is connected to the rear vertical motor connector terminals.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the rear vertical motor.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3617
72-9
SEAT
(d)
Reclining
Motor
Counterclockwise
Clockwise
21
Driving Axis
B35140
B57292
-
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
Check operation of the reclining motor.
(1) Check if the motor rotates smoothly when the battery is connected to the reclining motor connector
terminals.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the reclining motor.
5.
Lumbar Support Adjuster Motor
(a)
Counterclockwise
Clockwise
Driving Axis
B68209
Driver’s seat only:
INSPECT LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTER ASSY
Check operation of the lumbar support adjuster motor.
(1) Check if the motor rotates smoothly when the battery is connected to the lumbar support adjuster
motor connector terminals.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Operational Direction
Battery positive (+) → 1
Battery negative (-) → 2
Clockwise
Battery positive (+) → 2
Battery negative (-) → 1
Counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the adjuster motor.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3618
72-4
SEAT
-
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
720RF-01
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
Reclining Function
Lumbar Support
Function
Rear Vertical
Function
Front Vertical
Function
2.
CHECK POWER SEAT FUNCTION
Check the basic functions.
(1) Operate the power seat switches and check to
make sure each seat function works:
Sliding
Front vertical (driver’s seat only)
Rear vertical (driver’s seat only)
Reclining
Lumbar support (driver’s seat only)
Sliding Function
B76688
CHECK POWER SEAT MOTOR ASSY
(SLIDING, FRONT VERTICAL, REAR VERTICAL AND RECLINING FUNCTIONS)
HINT:
The front vertical function and rear vertical function are only available for the driver’s seat.
(a) Check the PTC operation inside the power seat motor.
HINT:
The PTC thermistor’s resistance increases when the power seat switch is held down even after the power
seat has been moved to the maximum in one direction. After the resistance increases, current is shut off to
prevent a short circuit.
NOTICE:
Perform steps (1) to (4) for the full range of motion for each power seat function.
(1) Choose a power seat function. Operate the power seat switch and move the seat to the maximum
in one direction. Keep the seat in that position for approximately 60 seconds.
(2) Operate the power seat switch again and continue to try to move the seat in the same direction
as in step (1). Measure the amount of time elapsed before the electrical current is automatically
cut. Check if electrical current has shut off by making sure the sound of the motor has stopped.
Standard: 4 to 90 seconds
(3) After the current has stopped, release the power seat switch and wait for approximately 60 seconds.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3613
72-5
SEAT
-
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
(4)
Operate the same power seat switch and move the seat to the opposite extreme of the direction
in step (1). Check that the motor operates.
(5) Repeat steps (1) to (4) for the remaining power seat functions.
3.
Driver’s seat only:
CHECK LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTER ASSY LH
(a) Check the PTC operation inside the power seat motor.
NOTICE:
The inspection should be performed with the seat installed in the vehicle.
(1) Operate the lumbar support switch and move the lumbar support to either the foremost or rearmost position. Keep the seat in that position for approximately 60 seconds.
(2) Operate the lumbar support switch again and continue to try to move the lumbar support in the
same direction as in step (1). Measure the amount of time elapsed before the electrical current
is automatically cut. Check if electrical current has shut off by making sure the sound of the motor
has stopped.
Standard: 4 to 90 seconds
(3) After the current has stopped, release the lumbar support switch and wait for approximately 60
seconds.
(4) Operate the lumbar support switch and move the seat to the opposite extreme of the direction
in step (1). Check that the motor operates.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3614
72-1
SEAT
-
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
720JM-02
LOCATION
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
POWER M-fuse
B78184
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3610
72-2
SEAT
-
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
Lumbar Support Motor
Reclining Motor
Reclining Motor
Front Power Seat Switch RH
Slide Motor
Front Vertical Motor
Rear Vertical Motor
Slide Motor
Power Seat Switch Assy
(Lumbar Support)
Front Power Seat Switch LH
B76690
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3611
72-3
SEAT
-
FRONT POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
720JJ-02
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspected Area
See Page
All power seat functions do not operate
1. POWER M-fuse
2. Wire harness
72-1
-
Only slide operation function does not operate
1. Front power seat switch
2. Slide motor
3. Wire harness
72-6
72-6
-
Only front vertical operation function does not operate
(driver’s seat only)
1. Front power seat switch
2. Front vertical motor
3. Wire harness
72-6
72-6
-
Only rear vertical operation function does not operate
(driver’s seat only)
1. Front power seat switch
2. Rear vertical motor
3. Wire harness
72-6
72-6
-
Only reclining operation function does not operate
1. Front power seat switch
2. Reclining motor
3. Wire harness
72-6
72-6
-
Only lumbar support operation function does not operate
(driver’s seat only)
1. Power seat switch assy (Lumbar support)
2. Lumbar support adjuster motor
3. Wire harness
72-6
72-6
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3612
72-10
SEAT
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (POWER SEAT TYPE)
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (POWER SEAT TYPE)
720JN-02
COMPONENTS
Front Seat Headrest Assy
Separate Type Front Seatback Pad
Front Seat Headrest Support
w/ Side Airbag:
Separate Type Front Seatback Cover
5.6 (57, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Seat Armrest Cover
Front Seatback
Board Sub-assy LH
37 (377, 27)
Seat Armrest
Assy LH
Hog Ring
Front Seatback
Board Cover
Separate Type Front
Seat Cushion Cover
Hog Ring
Clip
Separate Type Front
Seat Cushion Pad
Reclining Adjuster
Inside Cover RH
(Upper side)
Diver’s Seat Only:
Lumbar Support
Adjuster Assy LH
Front Seat
Adjuster LH
Reclining Adjuster Inside Cover RH (Lower side)
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy LH
Front Seat Cushion Shield Inner LH
36.7 (375, 27)
Reclining Adjuster
Inside Cover LH
(Upper side)
42 (428, 31)
36.7 (375, 27)
Passenger’s Seat Only:
Reclining Adjuster
Inside Cover LH
(Lower side)
Occupant Classification
ECU
Driver’s Seat Only:
Front Seat Cushion
Shield Inner No. 1 LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Driver’s Seat Only:
Seat Slide Position
Seat Position
Protector
Airbag Sensor
Front Seat
Cushion Shield LH
Front Power Seat
Switch LH
Power Seat Switch Knob
Driver’s Seat Only:
Power Seat Switch Assy
Seat Track Bracket Cover Inner Front LH
Seat Track Bracket
Cover Inner LH
Seat Track Bracket Cover
Outer LH
Front Seat Cushion
Shield Lower LH
Front Seat Cushion
Shield Lower RH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Seat Track Bracket Cover Outer Front LH
Non-reusable part
Front Seat Wire LH
B76689
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3619
72-1 1
SEAT
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (POWER SEAT TYPE)
720RH-03
OVERHAUL
CAUTION:
Wear safety gloves, because the cutting surfaces of the seatback frame and seat adjuster may
injure your hand.
Work must be started at least 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position
and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
(The SRS is equipped with a back-up power source. If work is started within 90 seconds from
disconnecting the negative (-) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS may deploy.)
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
When removing/installing and overhauling the passenger seat, check the passenger occupant classification system and perform the zero point calibration (see page 05-1203 ).
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
(a)
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
FRONT LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 3 claws and remove
the bracket cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3 Claws
B78036
2.
(a)
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER
FRONT LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the bracket cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2 Claws
B78309
3.
(a)
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove
the bracket cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4 Claws
B78310
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3620
72-12
SEAT
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (POWER SEAT TYPE)
4.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER LH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the bracket cover outer LH.
5.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSY LH
(a) Remove the headrest.
(b) Disconnect the connectors under the seat.
(c) Remove the 4 bolts and seat.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
6.
Passenger ’s seat only:
REMOVE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU (See page 60-64 )
7.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LH
(a) Remove the 2 rubber bands from the back of the front seatback board cover.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the 2 power seat switch knobs.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Remove the 7 screws.
(d) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and clip, and remove the cushion shield together with the
cushion shield inner and cushion shield inner No. 1.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip
(e)
(f)
4 Claws
B78336
Disconnect the connector of the power seat switch.
Remove the screw and disengage the claw using a screwdriver to remove the cushion shield from the
cushion shield inner No. 1.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
8.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD INNER LH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw and remove the cushion shield inner from the cushion shield
inner No. 1.
9.
REMOVE FRONT POWER SEAT SWITCH LH
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and seat switch.
10. Driver’s seat only:
REMOVE POWER SEAT SWITCH ASSY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and seat switch.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3621
72-13
SEAT
11.
12.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (POWER SEAT TYPE)
REMOVE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY LH (See page 61-4 )
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION COVER
Using a clip remover, remove the 2 clips on the cushion cover side.
w/ Seat heater:
Disconnect the seat heater connectors.
Disengage the hook and remove the hog rings and seat cushion cover together with the pad.
Remove the hog rings and cushion cover.
4 Claws
13.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT SEATBACK BOARD SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the 2 screws.
Lower the seatback board in the direction indicated by the
arrow in the illustration to disengage the 4 claws on the
upper part.
(c)
Hold the seatback board on the upper right and lower left
as shown in the illustration.
(d)
Turn the seatback board counterclockwise to disengage
the claws and remove it.
B78337
Hold
Hold
B78338
Counterclockwise
B78339
14.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT SEATBACK BOARD COVER SUB-ASSY
Disengage the hook on the upper part of the seatback board cover.
Remove the hog rings and seatback board cover.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3622
72-14
SEAT
15.
(a)
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (POWER SEAT TYPE)
REMOVE SEAT ARMREST ASSY LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the armrest cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the bolt and armrest.
2 Claws
B78965
16.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEATBACK
COVER
Remove the 2 headrest supports.
Remove the hog rings and seatback cover together with
the pad.
w/ Side airbag:
Remove the nut and seatback cover bracket.
Remove the hog rings and seatback cover.
B60977
17.
(a)
(b)
18.
(a)
19.
(a)
20.
(a)
21.
(a)
22.
(a)
23.
(a)
24.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Driver’s seat only:
REMOVE LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTER ASSY LH
Disconnect the connectors.
Remove the 2 screws and lumbar support adjuster.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER LH (UPPER SIDE)
Remove the screw and reclining adjuster cover.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER RH (UPPER SIDE)
Remove the screw and reclining adjuster cover.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER LH (LOWER SIDE)
Remove the 2 screws and reclining adjuster cover.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER RH (LOWER SIDE)
Remove the 2 screws and reclining adjuster cover.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LOWER LH
Remove the screw and cushion shield.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LOWER RH
Remove the screw and cushion shield.
Driver’s seat only:
REMOVE SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR
Disconnect the wire harness connector.
Disengage the claw and remove the seat slide position protector.
Using a torx socket wrench (T30), remove the torx bolt and airbag sensor.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3623
72-15
SEAT
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (POWER SEAT TYPE)
25.
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Slide Rail
Feeler Gauge
B76909
Driver’s seat only:
INSTALL SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) Temporarily install the seat position airbag sensor.
(b) Install a 1 mm (0.04 in.) feeler gauge between the slide
rail and sensor as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
If the seat position airbag sensor has been dropped,
or there are any cracks, dents or other defects in the
case, bracket or connector, replace the seat position
airbag sensor with a new one.
When installing the seat position airbag sensor, be
careful that the SRS wiring does not interfere with
other parts and is not pinched between other parts.
HINT:
Be sure to maintain a clearance between the seat position airbag sensor and the seat rail is within 0.6 mm (0.023 in.) to 2.0
mm (0.079 in.).
(c) Push the top of the sensor. While holding the sensor,
tighten the sensor using a torx socket wrench (T30).
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
(d) Install the seat slide position protector.
(e) Connect the wire harness connector.
26.
B50126
INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEATBACK
COVER
(a) Install the seatback pad.
(b) Cover the top of the seatback pad with the seatback cover.
(c) Using hog ring pliers, completely install the seatback cover with new hog rings.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent
wrinkles as much as possible.
(d) Install the 2 headrest supports.
(e)
w/ Side airbag:
Fully cover the airbag with the seatback cover bracket
and tighten the nut.
Torque: 5.6 N⋅m (57 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
B80142
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3624
72-16
SEAT
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (POWER SEAT TYPE)
NOTICE:
For a vehicle with side airbag, the side airbag may not
be activated normally unless the seatback cover is
securely installed.
Check that the strap has no twist after installing the
bracket.
Install the bracket securely.
27. INSTALL SEAT ARMREST ASSY LH
(a) Install the armrest with the bolt.
Torque: 37 N⋅m (377 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install the armrest cover.
28.
INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION
COVER
(a) Install the seat cushion.
(b) Using hog ring pliers, install the cushion cover to the cushion pad with new hog rings.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent
wrinkles as much as possible.
B50126
(c) w/ Seat heater:
Connect the seat heater connectors.
(d) Install the clip.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY LH (See page 61-4 )
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSY LH
Place the seat in the cabin.
Connect the connectors under the seat.
Tighten the 2 bolts on the front side of the seat.
Torque: 36.7 N⋅m (375 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
Tighten the 2 bolts on the rear side of the seat.
Torque: 36.7 N⋅m (375 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
Install the 4 seat track covers.
Install the headrest.
Connect the negative battery’s terminal.
INSPECT FUNCTION OF POWER SEAT OPERATION (See page 72-4 )
w/ Seat heater:
CHECK SEAT HEATER OPERATION
Hog Ring Pliers
29.
30.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
31.
32.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3625
72-17
SEAT
33.
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (POWER SEAT TYPE)
Passenger ’s seat only:
CHECK FUNCTION OF FRONT PASSENGER OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
HINT:
Perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity check when any of the following conditions is met.
The occupant classification ECU is replaced.
Accessories (seatback tray and seat cover, etc.) are installed.
The passenger seat is removed from the vehicle.
Both the SRS warning lamp and the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator lamp (”OFF”) turn on.
The vehicle is brought to the workshop for repair due to an accident or a collision.
(a) Zero point calibration procedure:
(1) Adjust the seat position according to the conditions below.
Adjustment Component
Position
Slide Direction
Rearmost position
Reclining Angle
Upright position
Headrest Height
Lowest position
(2)
(3)
(4)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Perform the zero point calibration by following the prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(b) Sensitivity check procedure.
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Apply a 30 kg weight (for example, a 30 kg of lead mass) onto the passenger seat.
(3) Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
(4) Using the hand-held tester, perform the sensitivity check and confirm that the sensitivity is within
the standard value.
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg
HINT:
When performing the sensitivity check, use a solid weight made from metal. The check results may
not be accurate if a weight made from liquid is used.
When the sensitivity deviates from the standard value, retighten the bolts of the passenger seat, taking
care not to deform the seat rail. Perform the sensitivity check again. If the sensitivity still is not within
the standard value, replace the front seat assembly RH.
NOTICE:
Do not place any objects on the seat. Perform the initialization by attaching a mass more than 2 kgs
in the seatback pocket, seatback table installed by the user or other appropriate location.
(c) Check the SRS warning lamp (see page 60-1 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3626
72-26
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
720RT-01
COMPONENTS
Rear Seat Lock Control
Lever Sub-assy LH
Rear Seat Lock
Control Lever Cover
Rear Seat Headrest Assy
Rear Seatback Board
Carpet Assy LH
Rear Seat Headrest Support
Hog Ring
Rear Seatback
Cover LH
Separate Type Rear
Seatback Cover
Clip
Separate Type Rear
Seat Cushion Cover
Hog Ring
Separate Type Rear
Seatback Pad
21 (214, 15)
Separate Type
Rear Seat Cushion Pad
21 (214, 15)
Rear Seat Reclining
Control No. 2 Cable
Rear Seat Cushion
Frame Sub-assy LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B78369
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3635
72-27
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
Rear Seatback Frame
Sub-assy LH
Tonneau Cover Hook Holder
42 (428, 31)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Rear Seat Cushion
Moulding Rear LH
Fold Seat Stopper
Band Assy No. 2
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Reclining
Cover Inner LH
18 (184, 13)
Rear Seat Belt
Assy Inner
Seat Track
Stop Plate LH
Fold Seat Cushion
Frame No. 1
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seatback Frame Sub-assy
Lower LH
Reclining Control
Link Sub-assy LH
42 (428, 31)
Fold Seat Cushion
Frame No. 2
18 (184, 13)
42 (428, 31)
E-Ring
Seat Hinge Rod
42 (428, 31)
36.7 (374, 27)
Rear Seat Cushion Moulding LH
36.7 (374, 27)
Rear Seat Track
Assy Inner LH
36.7 (374, 27)
36.7 (374, 27)
Rear Seat Track
Bracket Cover Inner
Rear Seat Track Assy Outer LH
Rear Seat Track
Adjusting Handle
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B78370
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3636
72-28
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
720JQ-03
OVERHAUL
HINT:
1.
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY (See page 76-21 )
2.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER
OUTER
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove
the bracket cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER
INNER
4 Claws
HINT:
B78372
Use the same procedures described for the bracket cover outer.
REMOVE REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH
Using a clip remover, remove the 3 clips.
4.
(a)
HINT:
Tape the clip remover tip before use.
(b) Remove the bolt holding the fold seat stopper band on the vehicle side.
(c) Remove the headrest.
(d) Remove the 5 bolts and seat.
Claw
5.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION MOULDING LH
Remove the 2 screws.
Remove the moulding by pulling it out in the arrow mark
direction shown in the illustration.
6.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION MOULDING REAR
LH
Remove the 3 screws.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 3 claws and remove
the moulding.
B78376
(a)
(b)
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3 Claws
B78377
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3637
72-29
SEAT
7.
(a)
(b)
8.
(a)
(b)
9.
(a)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSY LH
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), remove the 2 torx bolts.
Remove the 2 bolts and cushion.
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
Disengage the hook and remove the cushion cover together with the pad from the cushion.
Remove the hog rings and seat cushion cover.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER HOOK HOLDER
Remove the 2 screws and 2 holders.
10.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK COVER LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove
the seatback cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4 Claws
B78655
11.
(a)
4 Clips
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK BOARD CARPET ASSY
LH
Remove the 4 clips and seatback board carpet.
B78379
12.
Control Lever Cover
(a)
B68217
REMOVE REAR SEAT LOCK CONTROL LEVER
SUB-ASSY LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the seat lock control lever cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 screws.
(c) Disconnect the reclining remote control cable and remove
the seat lock control lever.
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEATBACK
COVER
Remove the 2 headrest supports.
Using a clip remover, remove the 2 clips.
Disengage the hook and remove the seatback cover together with the pad from the seatback frame.
Remove the hog rings and seatback cover.
B60977
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3638
72-30
SEAT
14.
(a)
15.
16.
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE FOLD SEAT STOPPER BAND ASSY NO.2
Remove the bolt and stopper band on the seat side.
DISCONNECT REAR SEAT RECLINING CONTROL NO. 2 CABLE
REMOVE REAR SEAT BELT ASSY INNER (See page 61-15 )
17.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER INNER LH
Remove the screw and the reclining cover in the direction
indicated by the arrow in the illustration.
B76718
18.
(a)
19.
(a)
20.
(a)
21.
(a)
(b)
22.
(a)
23.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK FRAME ASSY LH
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), remove the 4 torx bolts and seatback frame.
REMOVE RECLINING CONTROL LINK SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the 4 nuts and control link.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK STOP PLATE LH
Remove the 2 nuts and stop plate.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK FRAME SUB-ASSY LOWER LH
Outer side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), remove the 3 torx bolts.
Inner side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T55), remove the 2 torx bolts and seatback frame.
REMOVE FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.1
Remove the 2 nuts and cushion frame.
REMOVE FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.2
Remove the 2 nuts and cushion frame.
24. REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK ADJUSTING HANDLE
Screwdriver
(Less than 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)) (a) Using a screwdriver, push down the handle stopper to disengage the claw with the slide rail in the frontmost position. Remove the adjusting handle.
Screwdriver
Seat Track
Handle
Stopper
Track Adjusting Handle
B70385
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3639
72-31
SEAT
25.
(a)
26.
(a)
27.
(a)
(b)
28.
(a)
29.
(a)
30.
(a)
31.
32.
(a)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
INSTALL FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.1
Install the cushion frame with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.2
Install the cushion frame with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK FRAME SUB-ASSY LOWER LH
Outer side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), install the 3 torx bolts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
Inner side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T55), install the seatback frame with the 2 torx bolts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK FRAME ASSY LH
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), install the seatback frame with the 4 torx bolts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL SEAT TRACK STOP PLATE LH
Install the stop plate with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL RECLINING CONTROL LINK SUB-ASSY LH
Install the control link with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEAT BELT ASSY INNER (See page 61-15 )
INSTALL FOLD SEAT STOPPER BAND ASSY NO.2
Install the fold seat stopper band with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
33.
(a)
Hog Ring Pliers
B50126
INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEATBACK COVER
Using hog ring pliers, install the seatback cover to the
seatback pad with new hog rings.
(b) Install the seatback cover to the seatback frame.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent
wrinkles as much as possible.
(c) Install the 2 headrest supports.
34. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Using hog ring pliers, install the cushion cover to the cushion pad with new hog rings.
(b) Install the cushion cover to the cushion frame.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent wrinkles as much as possible.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3640
72-32
SEAT
35.
(a)
(b)
36.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSY LH
Hinge side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), install the seat cushion with the 2 torx bolts.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Cushion side:
Install the seat cushion with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH
Place the seat in the cabin.
Install the seat with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 36.7 N⋅m (375 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
Install the fold seat stopper band with the bolt on the vehicle side.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Install the headrest.
When sliding the seat, check that both sides of the adjuster lock simultaneously.
(d)
(e)
HINT:
Check that the seat adjuster locks.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3641
72-33
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
720JR-02
COMPONENTS
Rear Seat Lock Control
Lever Sub-assy RH
Rear Seat Headrest
Assy RH
Rear Seatback Lock Striker Cover RH
Rear Seat Headrest Assy Center
Rear Seat Headrest
Support
Rear Seatback Lock
Bezel Upper
No. 2 Center
Seatback Cover
Rear Seat Headrest
Support
Hog Ring
21 (214, 15)
Rear Seat Cushion
Spring No. 2
Separate Type Rear
Seatback Pad
Center Seatback
Frame Sub-assy
21 (214, 15)
Separate Type Rear
Seatback Cover
21 (214, 15)
Reclining Cover
Protector RH
21 (214, 15)
Center Back
Hinge
Rear Seatback Moulding RH
21 (214, 15)
21 (214, 15)
21 (214, 15)
Center Back
Hinge
Rear Seat Armrest
Assy Center
No. 1 Seatback Cover
Rear Seatback Moulding LH
Reclining Cover
Protector LH
Separate Type Rear
Seat Cushion Cover
Separate Type Rear
Seat Cushion Pad
Hog Ring
21 (214, 15)
21 (214, 15)
Rear Seat Cushion Frame Sub-assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B78510
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3642
72-34
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
Rear Seatback Board
Carpet Assy RH
Tonneau Cover Hook
Holder
Rear Seat Shoulder
Belt Cover
Rear Seatback
Cover RH
Rear Seatback Frame
Sub-assy RH
42 (428, 31)
Clip
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
Fold Seat Stopper
Band Assy No. 1
55 (561, 41)
Rear Seat Belt Assy
Outer Center
Rear Seat Belt Assy Inner
Rear Seat Reclining
Control Cable
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
18 (184, 13)
21 (214, 15)
Reclining Control Link
Sub-assy RH
42 (428, 31)
E-Ring
Seat Track Stop
Rear Seatback Frame
Sub-assy Lower RH
Plate RH
Rear Seat Cushion
Moulding RH
42 (428, 31)
Center Seat Hinge
Cover Upper LH
42 (428, 31)
Fold Seat Cushion
Frame No. 1
Rear Seat Reclining Cover
Inner RH
18 (184, 13)
120 (1224, 89)
42 (428, 31)
Seat Hinge Rod
Rear Seat Track Assy
Fold Seat Cushion
Frame No. 2
36.7 (375, 27)
Outer RH
36.7 (375, 27)
36.7 (375, 27)
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer
Rear Seat Cushion
Moulding Rear RH
36.7 (375, 27)
Rear Seat Track Assy
Inner RH
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Inner
Rear Seat Track Adjusting Handle
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B78511
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3643
72-35
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
720JS-03
OVERHAUL
HINT:
1.
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY (See page 76-21 )
2.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER
OUTER
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws remove the
bracket cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER
INNER
4 Claws
HINT:
B78372
Use the same procedures described for the bracket cover outer.
REMOVE REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH
Using a clip remover, remove the 5 clips.
4.
(a)
HINT:
Tape the clip remover tip before use.
(b) Remove the bolt holding the fold seat stopper band on the vehicle side.
(c) Remove the 2 headrests.
(d) Remove the 5 bolts and seat.
5.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER HOOK HOLDER
(a) Remove the 2 screws and 2 holders.
6.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK COVER RH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove
the seatback cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4 Claws
B78655
7.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK BOARD CARPET ASSY
RH
Remove the 6 clips and seatback board carpet.
Clip
6 Clips
B78487
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3644
72-36
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
8.
REMOVE RECLINING COVER PROTECTOR LH
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the clip.
HINT:
Tape the clip remover tip before use.
(b) Remove the screw and reclining cover protector by pulling out the protector in the direction indicated by the arrow
in the illustration.
B77393
Claw
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CENTER SEAT HINGE COVER UPPER LH
Remove the screw.
Using a screwdriver, remove the claw and hinge cover by
pulling out the cover in the direction indicated by the arrow
in the illustration.
10.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK ASSY CENTER
Remove the screw.
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), remove the torx
bolt.
Remove the 3 bolts and seatback.
B78490
(c)
B76711
11. REMOVE RECLINING COVER PROTECTOR RH
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the clip.
HINT:
Tape the clip remover tip before use.
(b) Remove the screw and reclining cover protector.
12. REMOVE REAR SEATBACK MOULDING LH
(a) Using a torx socket wrench (T40), remove the torx bolt and center back hinge.
(b) Using a torx socket wrench (T40), remove the torx bolt and rear seat cushion spring No. 2.
(c) Remove the 3 screws and moulding.
13. REMOVE REAR SEATBACK MOULDING RH
(a) Using a torx socket wrench (T40), remove the torx bolt and center back hinge.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and moulding.
14. REMOVE REAR SEAT ARMREST ASSY CENTER
(a) Using a torx socket wrench (T45), remove the 2 torx bolts and armrest.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3645
72-37
SEAT
15.
(a)
(b)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE NO.1 SEATBACK COVER
Remove the 2 headrest supports.
Disengage the claws and remove the seatback cover.
B60977
16.
(a)
REMOVE NO.2 CENTER SEATBACK COVER
Remove the 2 screws and seatback cover.
Claw
17.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION MOULDING RH
Remove the 2 screws.
Remove the moulding by pulling it out in the direction indicated by the arrow in the illustration.
18.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION MOULDING REAR
RH
Remove the 2 screws.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 3 claws and remove
the moulding.
B78491
(a)
(b)
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3 Claws
19.
(a)
(b)
20.
(a)
(b)
B78492
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSY RH
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), remove the 2 torx bolts.
Remove the 2 bolts and seat cushion.
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
Disengage the hook and remove the cushion cover together with the pad from the cushion frame.
Remove the hog rings and cushion cover.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3646
72-38
SEAT
21.
Control Lever Cover
(a)
B51234
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE REAR SEAT LOCK CONTROL LEVER
SUB-ASSY RH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the control lever cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 screws.
(c) Disconnect the reclining control cable and remove the
control lever.
22. REMOVE REAR SEATBACK LOCK BEZEL UPPER
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and 2 hooks.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the shoulder belt cover by pulling it out in the
direction indicated by the arrow in the illustration.
Hook
2 Claws
-
B78493
23.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEATBACK
COVER
Remove the 2 headrest supports.
Using a clip remover, remove the 2 clips.
Disengage the hook and remove the seatback cover together with the pad from the seatback frame.
Remove the hog rings and seatback cover.
B60977
24.
25.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SEAT BELT ASSY OUTER CENTER (See page 61-15 )
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK FRAME ASSY RH
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), remove the 2 torx bolts.
Remove the 2 bolts and seatback frame.
26.
(a)
2 Claws
27.
(a)
28.
29.
REMOVE REAR SEAT SHOULDER BELT COVER
Disengage the 2 claws and remove the belt cover by pulling it out in the direction indicated by the arrow in the illustration.
B78986
REMOVE FOLD SEAT STOPPER BAND ASSY NO.1
Remove the bolt and stopper band.
DISCONNECT REAR SEAT RECLINING CONTROL NO. 2 CABLE
REMOVE REAR SEAT BELT ASSY INNER (See page 61-15 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3647
72-39
SEAT
30.
(a)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER INNER RH
Remove the screw and the reclining cover in the direction
indicated by the arrow in the illustration.
B76716
31.
(a)
32.
(a)
33.
(a)
(b)
34.
(a)
35.
(a)
REMOVE SEAT TRACK STOP PLATE RH
Remove the 2 nuts and the seat track stop plate.
REMOVE RECLINING CONTROL LINK SUB-ASSY RH
Remove the bolt, 4 nuts and reclining control link.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK FRAME SUB-ASSY LOWER RH
Using a torx socket wrenches (T40), remove the 3 torx bolts.
Using a torx socket wrenches (T55), remove the 2 torx bolts and seatback frame.
REMOVE FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.1
Remove the 2 nuts and cushion frame.
REMOVE FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.2
Remove the 2 nuts and cushion frame.
36. REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK ADJUSTING HANDLE
Screwdriver
(Less than 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)) (a) Using a screwdriver, push down the handle stopper to disengage the claw with the slide rail in the frontmost position. Remove the track adjusting handle.
Screwdriver
Seat Track
Handle
Stopper
Track Adjusting Handle
B70385
37.
(a)
38.
(a)
INSTALL FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.1
Install the cushion frame with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.2
Install the cushion frame with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3648
72-40
SEAT
39.
(a)
(b)
40.
(a)
41.
(a)
42.
(a)
43.
44.
45.
(a)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK FRAME SUB-ASSY LOWER RH
Outer side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), install the seatback frame lower to the fold seat cushion frame with
the 3 torx bolts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
Inner side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T55), install the seatback frame lower to the fold seat cushion frame with
the 2 torx bolts.
Torque: 120 N⋅m (1224 kgf⋅cm, 89 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL SEAT TRACK STOP PLATE RH
Install the seat track stop plate with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL RECLINING CONTROL LINK SUB-ASSY RH
Install the control link with the bolt and 4 nuts.
Torque:
21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf) for bolt
42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf) for nut
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK FRAME ASSY RH
Install the seatback frame with the 4 bolts.
Torque:
42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf) for outside
55 N⋅m (561 kgf⋅cm, 41 ft⋅lbf) for inside
INSTALL REAR SEAT BELT ASSY INNER (See page 61-15 )
INSTALL REAR SEAT BELT ASSY OUTER CENTER (See page 61-15 )
INSTALL FOLD SEAT STOPPER BAND ASSY NO.1
Install the stopper band with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
46.
(a)
Hog Ring Pliers
B50126
INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEATBACK COVER
Using hog ring pliers, install the seatback cover to the
seatback pad with new hog rings.
(b) Install the seatback cover to the seatback frame.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent
wrinkles as much as possible.
(c) Install the 2 headrest supports.
47. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Using hog ring pliers, install the cushion cover to the cushion pad with new hog rings.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent wrinkles as much as possible.
(b) Install the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3649
72-41
SEAT
48.
(a)
(b)
49.
(a)
50.
(a)
(b)
(c)
51.
(a)
(b)
52.
(a)
(b)
(c)
53.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/O REAR NO.2 SEAT)
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSY RH
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), install the seat cushion with the 2 torx bolts.
Torque:21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf) for hinge side
Install the seat cushion assy with the 2 bolts.
Torque:18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf) for cushion side
INSTALL REAR SEAT ARMREST ASSY CENTER
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), install the armrest assy with the 2 torx bolts.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK MOULDING LH
Install the moulding with the 3 screws.
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), install the center back hinge with the torx bolt.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), install the rear seat cushion spring No. 2 with the torx bolt.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK MOULDING RH
Install the moulding with the 3 screws.
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), install the center back hinge with the torx bolt.
Torque:21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK ASSY CENTER
Install the screw.
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), install the seatback assy center with the torx bolt.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Install the seatback assy with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH
Place the seat in the cabin.
Install the seat with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 36.7 N⋅m (375 kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
Install the bolt onto the fold seat stopper band on the vehicle side.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Install the 2 headrests.
When sliding the seat, check that both sides of the adjuster lock simultaneously.
(d)
(e)
HINT:
Check that the seat adjuster locks.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3650
72-60
SEAT
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT ASSY
REAR NO.2 SEAT ASSY
720RK-01
COMPONENTS
Rear No. 2 Seat Headrest
Support Assy
Rear Side Seat Band
Sub-assy No. 2
No. 2 Seat
Headrest Assy
Rear Seat Cover
Bezel No. 1
Handle 3rd Seat
No. 2 Seatback
Board Assy
No. 2 Seatback Pad
No. 2 Seatback
Cover Assy
Hog Ring
No. 2 Seatback
Frame Sub-assy
Rear Seat Reclining
Cover Inner RH
Rear Seat Reclining
Cover No. 2 RH
Rear Seat Reclining
Cover Inner LH
Rear No. 1 Seat
Lock Cable Assy
Rear Seat Reclining
Cover No. 2 LH
No. 2 Seat
CushionPad
No. 2 Seat Leg RH
Reclining Pedal
Cover RH
Reclining Pedal
Cover LH
Hog Ring
37 (377, 27)
No. 2 Seat Cushion
Cover Sub-assy
42 (428, 31)
No. 2 Seat Cushion
Frame Sub-assy
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
21 (214, 15)
Non-reusable part
18 (184, 13)
No. 2 Seat Leg LH
B74631
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3669
72-61
SEAT
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT ASSY
720RL-02
OVERHAUL
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER ASSY (W/ TONNEAU COVER) (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY NO.2 (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY NO.3 (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX REAR (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM BOX LH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM BOX RH (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE DECK BOARD BRACKET REINFORCEMENT (See page 76-21 )
REMOVE RECLINING PEDAL COVER LH
Remove the screw and reclining pedal cover LH.
REMOVE RECLINING PEDAL COVER RH
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
(a)
10.
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
11. REMOVE REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER NO.2 LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and rear seat reclining cover No. 2 LH.
12. REMOVE REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER NO.2 RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
13. REMOVE REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER INNER LH
(a) Remove the screw and rear seat reclining cover inner LH.
14. REMOVE REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER INNER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
LH Side
15.
(a)
REMOVE REAR NO.2 SEAT ASSY
Remove the 4 bolts and rear No. 2 seat.
16.
(a)
REMOVE REAR NO.2 SEAT LEG LH
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), remove the sub seat
bolt.
Remove the 4 bolts and rear No. 2 seat leg LH.
REMOVE REAR NO.2 SEAT LEG RH
B74633
LH Side
(a)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(b)
17.
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
(b)
B76592
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3670
72-62
SEAT
18.
(a)
(b)
Hook
(c)
A
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT ASSY
REMOVE NO.2 SEAT CUSHION COVER SUB-ASSY
Remove the 4 clips and hook.
Remove the hog rings and seat cushion cover together
with the pad from the seat cushion frame.
Remove the hog rings and seat cushion cover from the
seat cushion pad.
A
A
Clip
B75783
19.
REMOVE REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSY
20.
(a)
(b)
(c)
2 Claws
REMOVE HANDLE 3RD SEAT
Remove the 2 screws.
Disengage the 2 claws.
Disconnect the rear No. 1 seat cable and remove the handle 3rd seat.
B74635
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3671
72-63
SEAT
21.
(a)
(b)
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT ASSY
REMOVE NO.2 SEATBACK BOARD ASSY
Remove the 7 clips.
Disengage the 3 claws and remove the seatback board.
2nd
1st
3 Claws
7 Clips
B75784
22.
(a)
(b)
(c)
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
REMOVE NO.2 SEATBACK COVER ASSY
Remove the 2 headrest supports.
Remove the hog rings and seatback cover together with the pad from the seatback frame.
Remove the hog rings and seatback cover from the seatback pad.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEAT BAND SUB-ASSY NO.2
REMOVE REAR SEAT COVER BEZEL NO.1
REMOVE REAR NO.1 SEAT LOCK CABLE ASSY
INSTALL REAR NO.1 SEAT LOCK CABLE ASSY
INSTALL REAR SEAT COVER BEZEL NO.1
INSTALL REAR SIDE SEAT BAND SUB-ASSY NO.2
29. INSTALL NO.2 SEATBACK COVER ASSY
(a) Install the seatback cover to the seatback pad with new
hog rings.
(b) Install the seatback cover with the pad to the seatback
frame with new hog rings.
HINT:
When installing hog rings, take care to prevent wrinkles as little
as possible.
B50126
30.
31.
32.
INSTALL NO.2 SEATBACK BOARD ASSY
INSTALL HANDLE 3RD SEAT
INSTALL REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSY
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3672
72-64
SEAT
33.
(a)
(b)
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT ASSY
INSTALL NO.2 SEAT CUSHION COVER SUB-ASSY
Install the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion pad with
new hog rings.
Install the seat cushion cover with the pad to the seat
cushion frame with new hog rings.
HINT:
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent wrinkles as
much as possible.
B50126
Hook
(c)
Install the 4 clips and hook.
34.
(a)
INSTALL REAR NO.2 SEAT LEG LH
Install the rear No. 2 seat leg LH with the sub seat bolt and
4 bolts.
Torque:
21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf) for bolt A
42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf) for bolt B
18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf) for bolt C
INSTALL REAR NO.2 SEAT LEG RH
A
A
A
Clip
B75783
LH Side
Sub Seat Bolt
B
B
C
A
B76592
35.
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3673
72-65
SEAT
36.
(a)
LH Side
-
REAR NO.2 SEAT ASSY
INSTALL REAR NO.2 SEAT ASSY
Install the rear No. 2 seat with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 37 N⋅m (377 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
B74633
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3674
72-18
SEAT
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (MANUAL SEAT TYPE)
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (MANUAL SEAT TYPE)
720RI-01
COMPONENTS
Front Seat Headrest Assy
Front Seat Headrest Support
Separate Type Front Seatback Cover
Separate Type Front Seatback Pad
w/ Side Airbag:
5.6 (57, 48 in.⋅lbf)
Seat Armrest Cover
37 (377, 27)
Front Seatback
Board Sub-assy LH
Seat Armrest
Assy LH
Hog Ring
Separate Type Front
Seat Cushion Cover
Clip
Hog Ring
Front Seatback
Board Cover
Separate Type Front
Seat Cushion Pad
Front Seat Wire LH
Front Seat Adjuster LH
Front Seat Inner Belt Assy LH
Reclining Adjuster Inside Cover RH
(Upper side)
Front Seat Cushion
Shield Inner LH
42 (428, 31)
Reclining Adjuster
Inside Cover LH
(Upper side)
36.7 (375, 27)
Seat Track Bracket
Cover Inner LH
36.7 (375, 27)
Passenger’s Seat Only:
Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer LH
Occupant Classification ECU
Reclining Adjuster Inside
Cover RH (Lower side)
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Driver’s Seat Only:
Driver’s Seat Only:
Seat Slide Position Protector
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
Seat Track Bracket Cover
Inner Front LH
Seat Track Bracket Cover
Outer Front LH
Front Seat Cushion
Shield LH
Driver’s Seat Only:
Vertical Adjuster
Handle No. 2
Reclining Adjuster
Release Handle LH
Reclining Adjuster
Inside Cover LH
(Lower side)
Front Seat Cushion
Snap Ring
Shield Lower RH
Front Seat Cushion
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Shield Lower LH
Non-reusable part
Driver’s Seat Only:
Vertical Seat Adjuster
Knob LH
Driver’s Seat Only:
Vertical Adjuster
Handle Cover LH
B76692
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3627
72-19
SEAT
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (MANUAL SEAT TYPE)
720RJ-02
OVERHAUL
CAUTION:
Wear safety gloves, because the cutting surface of the seatback frame and seat adjuster may
injure your hand.
Work must be at least 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position and
the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
(The SRS is equipped with a back-up power source. If work is started within 90 seconds from
disconnecting the negative (-) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS may deploy.)
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
When removing/installing and overhauling the passenger seat, check the passenger occupant classification system and perform the zero point calibration (see page 05-1203 ).
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
(a)
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER
FRONT LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage 2 claws and remove the
bracket cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2 Claws
B78351
2.
(a)
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER
FRONT LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the bracket cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2 Claws
B78352
3.
(a)
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER OUTER LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the bracket cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2 Claws
B78353
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3628
72-20
SEAT
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (MANUAL SEAT TYPE)
4.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER INNER LH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the bracket cover outer LH.
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
5.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSY LH
(a) Remove the headrest.
(b) Disconnect the connectors under the seat.
(c) Remove the 4 bolts and seat.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
6.
Passenger ’s seat only:
REMOVE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU (See page 60-64 )
7.
(a)
Driver’s seat only:
REMOVE VERTICAL SEAT ADJUSTER KNOB LH
Using a cloth, remove the snap rings and vertical seat adjuster knob.
B76691
8.
(a)
Driver’s seat only:
REMOVE VERTICAL ADJUSTING HANDLE NO.2
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 3 claws and remove
the vertical adjuster handle cover LH.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and vertical adjusting handle.
3 Claws
B78347
9.
(a)
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER RELEASE HANDLE
LH
Using a screwdriver, pry out the reclining adjuster release
handle.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Claw
B78348
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3629
72-21
SEAT
10.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (MANUAL SEAT TYPE)
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LH
Remove the 2 rubber bands from the back of the seatback
board cover.
Remove the screw.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and clip, and
remove the cushion shield.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2 Claws
Clip
B78349
11.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD INNER LH
Remove the screw.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and clip, and
remove the cushion shield.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2 Claws
Clip
B78350
12.
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY LH (See page 61-4 )
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION COVER
Remove the 2 clips on the cushion cover side.
w/ Seat heater:
Disconnect the seat heater connectors.
Disengage the hook and remove the hog rings and seat cushion cover together with the pad.
Remove the hog rings and cushion cover.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3630
72-22
SEAT
4 Claws
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (MANUAL SEAT TYPE)
14.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT SEATBACK BOARD SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the 2 screws.
Lower the seatback board in the direction indicated by the
arrow in the illustration to disengage the 4 claws on the
upper part.
(c)
Hold the seatback board on the upper right and lower left
as shown in the illustration.
(d)
Turn the seatback board counterclockwise to disengage
the claws and remove it.
B78337
Hold
Hold
B78338
Counterclockwise
B78339
15.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT SEATBACK BOARD COVER SUB-ASSY
Disengage the hook on the upper part of the seatback board cover.
Remove the hog rings and seatback board cover.
16.
(a)
REMOVE SEAT ARMREST ASSY LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the armrest cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the bolt and armrest.
2 Claws
B78965
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3631
72-23
SEAT
17.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (MANUAL SEAT TYPE)
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEATBACK
COVER
Remove the 2 headrest supports.
Remove the hog rings and seatback cover together with
the pad.
w/ Side airbag:
Remove the nut and seatback cover bracket.
Remove the hog rings and seatback cover.
B60977
18.
(a)
19.
(a)
20.
(a)
21.
(a)
22.
(a)
23.
(a)
24.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER LH (UPPER SIDE)
Remove the screw and cushion shield.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER RH (UPPER SIDE)
Remove the screw and cushion shield.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER LH (LOWER SIDE)
Remove the screw and cushion shield.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER RH (LOWER SIDE)
Remove the screw and cushion shield.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LOWER LH
Disengage the claw and remove the cushion shield.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LOWER RH
Disengage the claw and remove the cushion shield.
Driver’s seat only:
REMOVE SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR
Disconnect the wire harness connector.
Disengage the claw and remove the seat slide position protector.
Using a torx socket wrench (T30), remove the torx bolt and airbag sensor.
25.
(a)
(b)
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Slide Rail
Feeler Gauge
B76909
INSTALL SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR
Temporarily install the seat position airbag sensor.
Install a 1 mm (0.04 in.) feeler gauge between the slide
rail and sensor as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
If the seat position airbag sensor has been dropped,
or there are any cracks, dents or other defects in the
case, bracket or connector, replace the seat position
airbag sensor with a new one.
When installing the seat position airbag sensor, be
careful that the SRS wiring does not interfere with
other parts and is not pinched between other parts.
HINT:
Be sure to that a clearance between the seat position airbag
sensor and the seat rail is within 0.6 mm (0.023 in.) to 2 mm
(0.079 in.).
(c) Push the top of the sensor. While holding the sensor,
tighten the sensor using a torx socket wrench (T30).
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3632
72-24
SEAT
(d)
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (MANUAL SEAT TYPE)
Install the seat slide position protector.
26.
Hog Ring Pliers
B50126
INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEATBACK
COVER
(a) Install the seatback pad.
(b) Cover the top of the seatback pad with the seatback cover.
(c) Using hog ring pliers, completely install the seatback cover with new hog rings.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent
wrinkles as much as possible.
(d) Install the 2 headrest supports.
(e)
B80142
Hog Ring Pliers
B50126
29.
w/ Side airbag:
Fully cover the airbag with the seatback cover bracket
and tighten the nut.
Torque: 5.6 N⋅m (57 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
NOTICE:
For a vehicle with side airbag, the side airbag may not
be activated normally unless the seatback cover is
securely installed.
Check that the strap has no twist after installing the
bracket.
Install the bracket securely.
27. INSTALL SEAT ARMREST ASSY LH
(a) Install the armrest with the bolt.
Torque: 37 N⋅m (377 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
(b) Install the armrest cover.
28. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION
COVER
(a) Install the seat cushion.
(b) Using hog ring pliers, install the cushion cover to the cushion pad with new hog rings.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent
wrinkles as much as possible.
(c) w/ Seat heater:
Connect the seat heater connectors.
(d) Install the clip.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSY LH (See page 61-4 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3633
72-25
SEAT
30.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
31.
32.
-
FRONT SEAT ASSY LH (MANUAL SEAT TYPE)
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSY LH
Place the seat in the cabin.
Connect the connectors under the seat.
Tighten the 2 bolts on the front side of the seat.
Torque: 36.7 N⋅m (375 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
Tighten the 2 bolts on the rear side of the seat.
Torque: 36.7 N⋅m (375 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
Install the 4 seat track covers.
Install the headrest.
Connect the battery’s negative terminal.
w/ Seat heater:
CHECK SEAT HEATER OPERATION
Passenger ’s seat only:
CHECK FUNCTION OF FRONT PASSENGER OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
HINT:
Perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity check when any of the following conditions is met.
The occupant classification ECU is replaced.
Accessories (seatback tray and seat cover, etc.) are installed.
The passenger seat is removed from the vehicle.
Both the SRS warning lamp and the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator lamp (”OFF”) turn on.
The vehicle is brought to the workshop for repair due to an accident or a collision.
(a) Zero point calibration procedure:
(1) Adjust the seat position according to the table below.
Adjustment Component
Position
Slide Direction
Rearmost position
Reclining Angle
Upright position
Headrest Height
Lowest position
(2)
(3)
(4)
Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Perform the zero point calibration by following the prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the hand-held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(b) Sensitivity check procedure:
(1) Connect the hand-held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Apply a 30 kg weight (for example, a 30 kg of lead mass) onto the passenger seat.
(3) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(4) Using the hand-held tester, perform the sensitivity check and confirm that the sensitivity is within
the standard value.
Standard value: 27 to 33 kg
HINT:
When performing the sensitivity check, use a solid weight made from metal. The check results may
not be accurate if a weight made from liquid is used.
When the sensitivity deviates from the standard value, retighten the bolts of the passenger seat, taking
care not to deform the seat rail. Perform the sensitivity check again. If the sensitivity still is not within
the standard value, replace the front seat assembly RH.
NOTICE:
Do not place any objects on the seat. Perform the initialization by attaching a mass more than 2 kgs
in the seatback pocket, seatback table installed by the user, or other appropriate location.
(c) Check the SRS warning lamp (see page 60-1 ).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3634
72-42
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
720RR-01
COMPONENTS
Rear Seat Headrest Support
No.2 Center Seatback Cover
Rear Seat Headrest Assy Center
21 (214, 15)
Stopper
Reclining Cover Protector RH
Center Seatback Frame
21 (214, 15)
21 (214, 15)
Center Back Hinge
Rear Seatback
Moulding LH
Rear Seat Cushion
Spring No. 2
Rear Seatback Moulding RH
21 (214, 15)
Reclining cover
Protector LH
No. 1 Seatback
Cover
21 (214, 15)
Center Back Hinge
Rear Seat Headrest Assy
Rear Seat Lock Control
Lever Sub-Assy LH
Rear Seat Headrest Support
Rear Seat Armrest Assy Center
Rear Seatback Lock
Bezel Upper
Hog Ring
Separate Type Rear Seat
Cushion Cover
Rear Seatback Lock
Striker Cover
Separate Type Rear Seat
Cushion Pad
21 (214, 15)
Separate Type Rear
Seatback Cover
Hog Ring
21 (214, 15)
Separate Type Rear
Seatback Pad
Rear Seat Cushion Frame LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Vertical Adjuster Bracket Cover Outer
B76695
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3651
72-43
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
Rear Seatback Cover LH
Rear Seat Shoulder Belt Cover
Rear Seatback Frame LH
Tonneau Cover
Hook Holder
55 (561, 41)
9.0 (92, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Rear Seatback Board
Carpet Assy LH
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Belt Assy
Rear Seatback
Rear Seat Reclining
Outer Center
Frame LH
Control Cable
42 (428, 31)
Reclining Control Link
21 (214, 15)
Sub-assy LH
Seat Track Stop Plate LH
42 (428, 31)
Center Seat Hinge Cover Upper RH
18 (184, 13)
Rear Seat Cushion
Seat Track Upper Rail Cover LH
Moulding Rear LH
E-Ring
18 (184, 13)
42 (428, 31)
120 (1224, 89)
Fold Seat Cushion
Rear Seatback Frame
42 (428, 31)
Sub-assy Lower LH
Frame No. 2
Rear Seat Reclining
Fold Seat Cushion
Seat Hinge Rod
Cover Inner LH
Rear Seat Track Assy
Frame No. 1
Rear Seat Track Bracket
36.7 (375, 27)
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Belt Assy Inner
Reclining Adjuster Inside
Cover Inner LH
Inner LH
36.7 (375, 27)
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Inner
42 (428, 31)
Cover LH
Rear Seat Track Bracket
36.7 (375, 27)
Rear Seat Track
Adjusting Handle
Cover Outer LH
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Reclining Hinge
Cover Outer
Cover LH
Rear Seat Track Assy
Rear Seat Cushion
Outer LH
Moulding LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B78189
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3652
72-44
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
720RS-03
OVERHAUL
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
(a)
4 Claws
4 Clips
B78988
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER
OUTER
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove
the bracket cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2.
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER
INNER
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the bracket cover outer.
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER
OUTER LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 clips and remove
the cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B78537
4.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER
INNER LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 clips and remove
the cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4 Clips
5.
(a)
(b)
6.
(a)
B78538
REMOVE REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH
Remove the 2 headrests.
Remove the 5 bolts and seat.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER HOOK HOLDER
Remove the 2 screws and 2 holders.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3653
72-45
SEAT
7.
(a)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK COVER LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove
the seatback cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4 Claws
B78655
8.
(a)
11 Clips
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK BOARD CARPET ASSY
LH
Using a clip remover, disengage the 11 clips and remove
seatback board carpet.
B78541
9.
REMOVE RECLINING COVER PROTECTOR RH
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the clip.
HINT:
Tape the clip remover tip before use.
(b) Remove the screw and reclining cover protector by pulling out the protector in the direction indicated by the arrow
in the illustration.
B80295
10.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CENTER SEAT HINGE COVER UPPER RH
Remove the screw.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw and remove the
hinge cover by pulling it out in the direction indicated by
the arrow in the illustration.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Claw
B78543
11.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SEAT TRACK UPPER RAIL COVER LH
Remove the 2 screws.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw and remove the
cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Claw
B78544
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3654
72-46
SEAT
12.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK ASSY CENTER
Remove the screw.
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), remove the torx
bolt.
Remove the 3 bolts and seatback.
B78545
13. REMOVE RECLINING COVER PROTECTOR LH
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the clip.
HINT:
Tape the clip remover tip before use.
(b) Remove the screw and reclining cover protector.
14. REMOVE REAR SEATBACK MOULDING LH
(a) Using a torx socket wrench (T40), remove the torx bolt and center back hinge.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and moulding.
15. REMOVE REAR SEATBACK MOULDING RH
(a) Using a torx socket wrench (T40), remove the torx bolt and center back hinge.
(b) Using a torx socket wrench (T40), remove the torx bolt and rear seat cushion spring No. 2.
(c) Remove the 3 screws and moulding.
16. REMOVE REAR SEAT ARMREST ASSY CENTER
(a) Using a torx socket wrench (T45), remove the 2 torx bolts and armrest.
17.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE NO.1 SEATBACK COVER
Remove the 2 headrest supports.
Disengage the claws and remove the seatback cover.
B60977
18.
(a)
REMOVE NO.2 CENTER SEATBACK COVER
Remove the 2 screws and seatback cover.
19.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION MOULDING LH
Remove the 2 screws.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove
the moulding by pulling out the moulding in the direction
indicated by the arrow in the illustration.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4 Claws
B78546
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3655
72-47
SEAT
20.
(a)
(b)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE VERTICAL ADJUSTER BRACKET COVER
OUTER
Remove the screw.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the bracket cover by pulling it out in the direction indicated
by the arrow in the illustration.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2 Claws
B78547
21.
(a)
REMOVE RECLINING HINGE COVER LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and 2 clips
and remove the hinge cover by pulling it out in the direction indicated by the arrow in the illustration.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2 Claws
2 Clips
B78548
22.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION MOULDING REAR
LH
Remove the 2 screws.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 3 claws and remove
the moulding.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3 Claws
23.
(a)
(b)
24.
(a)
(b)
B78549
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSY LH
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), remove the 2 torx bolts.
Remove the 2 bolts and seat cushion.
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
Disengage the hook and remove the cushion cover together with the pad from the cushion frame.
Remove the hog rings and cushion cover.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3656
72-48
SEAT
25.
Control Lever Cover
(a)
B68217
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE REAR SEAT LOCK CONTROL LEVER
SUB-ASSY LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the control lever cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 screws.
(c) Disconnect the reclining control cable and remove the
control lever.
26. REMOVE REAR SEATBACK LOCK BEZEL UPPER
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and 2 hooks.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the shoulder belt cover by pulling it out in the
direction indicated by the arrow in the illustration.
2 Hooks
2 Claws
-
B78493
27.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEATBACK
COVER
Remove the 2 headrest supports.
Using a clip remover, remove the 2 clips.
Disengage the hook and remove the seatback cover together with the pad from the seatback frame.
Remove the hog rings and seatback cover.
B60977
28.
29.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SEAT BELT ASSY OUTER CENTER (See page 61-15 )
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK FRAME ASSY LH
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), remove the 2 torx bolts.
Remove the 2 bolts and seatback frame.
30.
(a)
2 Claws
31.
32.
REMOVE REAR SEAT SHOULDER BELT COVER
Disengage the 2 claws and remove the belt cover by pulling it out in the direction indicated by the arrow in the illustration.
B78494
DISCONNECT REAR SEAT RECLINING CONTROL NO. 2 CABLE
REMOVE REAR SEAT BELT ASSY INNER (See page 61-15 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3657
72-49
SEAT
33.
(a)
(b)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER INNER LH
Remove the screw.
Remove the reclining cover in the direction indicated by
the arrow in the illustration.
B78620
34.
(a)
35.
(a)
36.
(a)
37.
(a)
(b)
38.
(a)
39.
(a)
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER LH
Remove the screw and inside cover.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK STOP PLATE LH
Remove the 2 nuts and stop plate.
REMOVE RECLINING CONTROL LINK SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the bolt, 4 nuts and reclining control link.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK FRAME SUB-ASSY LOWER LH
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), remove the 3 torx bolts.
Using a torx socket wrench (T55), remove the 2 torx bolts and seatback frame.
REMOVE FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.1
Remove the 2 nuts and cushion frame.
REMOVE FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.2
Remove the 2 nuts and cushion frame.
Screwdriver
(Less than 2.0 mm (0.079 in.))
40.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK ADJUSTING HANDLE
Using a screwdriver, push down the handle stopper to disengage the claw with the slide rail in the frontmost position. Remove the track adjusting handle.
Screwdriver
Seat Track
Handle
Stopper
Track Adjusting Handle
B70385
41.
(a)
INSTALL FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.1
Install the cushion frame with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3658
72-50
SEAT
42.
(a)
43.
(a)
(b)
44.
(a)
45.
(a)
46.
(a)
47.
48.
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
INSTALL FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.2
Install the cushion frame with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK FRAME SUB-ASSY LOWER LH
Outer side side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), install the seatback frame lower to the fold seat cushion frame with
the 3 torx bolts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
Inner side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T55), install the seatback frame lower to the fold seat cushion frame with
the 2 torx bolts.
Torque: 120 N⋅m (1224 kgf⋅cm, 89 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL SEAT TRACK STOP PLATE LH
Install the seat track stop plate with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL RECLINING CONTROL LINK SUB-ASSY LH
Install the control link with the bolt and 4 nuts.
Torque:
21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf) for bolt
42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf) for nut
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK FRAME ASSY LH
Install the seatback frame with the 4 bolts.
Torque:
42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf) for outside
55 N⋅m (561 kgf⋅cm, 41 ft⋅lbf) for inside
INSTALL REAR SEAT BELT ASSY INNER (See page 61-15 )
INSTALL REAR SEAT BELT ASSY OUTER CENTER (See page 61-15 )
49.
(a)
Hog Ring Pliers
B50126
INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEATBACK COVER
Using hog ring pliers, install the seatback cover to the
seatback pad with new hog rings.
(b) Install the seatback cover to the seatback frame.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent
wrinkles as much as possible.
(c) Install the 2 headrest supports.
50. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Using hog ring pliers, install the cushion cover to the cushion pad with new hog rings.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent wrinkles as much as possible.
(b) Install the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3659
72-51
SEAT
51.
(a)
(b)
52.
(a)
53.
(a)
(b)
54.
(a)
(b)
(c)
55.
(a)
(b)
(c)
56.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSY LH
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), install the seat cushion with the 2 torx bolts.
Torque:21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf) for hinge side
Install the seat cushion with the 2 bolts.
Torque:18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf) for cushion side
INSTALL REAR SEAT ARMREST ASSY CENTER
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), install the armrest with the 2 torx bolts.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK MOULDING LH
Install the moulding with the 3 screws.
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), install the center back hinge with the torx bolt.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK MOULDING RH
Install the moulding with the 3 screws.
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), install the center back hinge with the torx bolt.
Torque:21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), install the rear seat cushion spring No. 2 with the torx bolt.
Torque:21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK ASSY CENTER
Install the screw.
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), install the seatback assy with the torx bolt.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
Install the seatback assy with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH
Place the seat in the cabin.
Install the seat with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 36.7 N⋅m (375 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
Install the bolt onto the fold seat stopper band on the vehicle side.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
Install the 2 headrests.
When sliding the seat, check that both sides of the adjuster lock simultaneously.
(d)
(e)
HINT:
Check that the seat adjuster locks.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3660
72-52
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
720RP-02
COMPONENTS
Rear Seat Lock Control Lever Sub-Assy RH
Rear Seat Headrest Assy
Rear Seatback Lock Striker Cover
Rear Seatback
Cover RH
Rear Seat Headrest Support
Hog Ring
Cover
Remote Control
Lever Knob RH
Cover
Rear Seatback Board
Carpet Assy RH
Rear Seat Cover Bezel No. 1
Separate Type Rear Seatback Pad
Separate Type Rear Seatback Cover
Hog Ring
Separate Type Rear
Seat Cushion Cover
Rear Seat Reclining
Control No. 2 Cable
Separate Type Rear
Seat Cushion Pad
Vertical Adjuster Bracket
Cover Outer
21 (214, 15)
21 (214, 15)
Rear Seat Cushion Frame RH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B76693
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3661
72-53
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
Rear Seatback Frame RH
Tonneau Cover Hook Holder
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Cushion Moulding RH
42 (428, 31)
Rear Back Lock Control
Lever Sub-Assy RH
18 (184, 13)
18 (184, 13)
Reclining Adjuster Inside
Cover RH
42 (428, 31)
Seat Track Stop Plate RH
Rear Seatback Frame
Sub-Assy Lower
Fold Seat Cushion Frame No. 1
Reclining Control Link
Sub-Assy RH
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Belt
Assy Inner
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Cushion
Moulding Rear RH
42 (428, 31)
Rear Seat Reclining Cover Inner RH
42 (428, 31)
18 (184, 13)
Seat Track Upper Rail Cover RH
18 (184, 13)
Seat Hinge Rod
E-Ring
Rear Seat Track Assy
Outer RH
Fold Seat Cushion Frame No. 2
42 (428, 31)
36.7 (374, 27)
Rear Seat Track Bracket Cover Outer RH
Reclining Hinge Cover RH
36.7 (374, 27)
36.7 (374, 27)
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Outer
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Inner RH
Rear Seat Track Assy Inner RH
36.7 (374, 27)
Rear Seat Track Adjusting Handle
Rear Seat Track Bracket
Cover Inner
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B76694
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3662
72-54
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
720RQ-03
OVERHAUL
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
(a)
4 Claws
4 Clips
B78372
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2.
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER
INNER
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the bracket cover outer.
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER
OUTER RH
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 clips and remove
the cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B78621
4.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER
INNER RH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw and 3 clips and
remove the cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip
Claw
3 Clips
5.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK BRACKET COVER
OUTER
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove
the 2 covers.
B78622
REMOVE REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH
Remove the headrest.
Remove the 5 bolts and seat.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3663
72-55
SEAT
6.
(a)
(b)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION MOULDING REAR
RH
Remove the 2 screws.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove
the moulding by pulling it out in the arrow mark direction
shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4 Claws
B78623
7.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION MOULDING RH
Remove the 2 screws.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 5 claws and remove
the moulding by pulling it out in the arrow mark direction
shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
5 Claws
B78624
8.
(a)
(b)
2 Claws
B78625
9.
(a)
2 Claws
2 Clips
10.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE VERTICAL ADJUSTER BRACKET COVER
OUTER
Remove the screw.
Disengage the 2 claws and remove the bracket cover by
pulling it out in the arrow mark direction shown in the illustration.
REMOVE RECLINING HINGE COVER RH
Disengage the 2 clips and 2 claws and remove the hinge
cover by pulling it out in the arrow mark direction shown
in the illustration.
B78626
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSY RH
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), remove the 2 bolts.
Remove the 2 bolts and cushion.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3664
72-56
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
11. REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Disengage the hook and remove the cushion cover together with the pad from the cushion frame.
(b) Remove the hog rings and seat cushion cover.
12. REMOVE SEAT TRACK UPPER RAIL COVER RH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and rail cover.
13. REMOVE REMOTE CONTROL LEVER KNOB RH
(a) Remove the screw and control lever knob.
14. REMOVE REAR SEAT COVER BEZEL NO.1
(a) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove the 2 covers.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and seat cover bezel.
15. REMOVE TONNEAU COVER HOOK HOLDER
(a) Remove the 2 screws and 2 holders.
16.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK COVER RH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove
the seatback cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
: 4 Claws
B78655
17.
(a)
7 Clips
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK BOARD CARPET ASSY
RH
Using a clip remover, disengage the 7 clips and remove
seatback board carpet.
B78627
18.
Control Lever Cover
(a)
B51234
REMOVE REAR SEAT LOCK CONTROL LEVER
SUB-ASSY RH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the seat lock control lever cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 screws.
(c) Disconnect the reclining remote control cable and remove
the seat lock control lever.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3665
72-57
SEAT
19.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEATBACK
COVER
Remove the 2 headrest supports.
Using a clip remover, remove the 2 clips.
Disengage the hook and remove the seatback cover together with the pad from the seatback frame.
Remove the hog rings and seatback cover.
B60977
20.
21.
DISCONNECT REAR SEAT RECLINING CONTROL NO. 2 CABLE
REMOVE REAR SEAT BELT ASSY INNER (See page 61-15 )
22.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER INNER RH
Remove the screw and reclining cover by pulling out the
cover in the arrow mark direction shown in the illustration.
B78628
23.
(a)
24.
(a)
25.
(a)
26.
(a)
27.
(a)
28.
(a)
(b)
29.
(a)
30.
(a)
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER INSIDE COVER RH
Remove the screw and inside cover.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK FRAME ASSY RH
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), remove the 4 torx bolts and seatback frame.
REMOVE RECLINING CONTROL LINK SUB-ASSY RH
Remove the 4 nuts and control link.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK STOP PLATE RH
Remove the 2 nuts and stop plate.
REMOVE REAR BACK LOCK CONTROL LEVER SUB-ASSY RH
Remove the 3 nuts and control lever.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK FRAME SUB-ASSY LOWER LH
Outer side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), remove the 3 torx bolts.
Inner side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T55), remove the 2 torx bolts and seatback frame.
REMOVE FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.1
Remove the 2 nuts and cushion frame.
REMOVE FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.2
Remove the 2 nuts and cushion frame.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3666
72-58
SEAT
Screwdriver
(Less than 2.0 mm (0.079 in.))
31.
(a)
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
REMOVE REAR SEAT TRACK ADJUSTING HANDLE
Using a screwdriver, push down the handle stopper to disengage the claw with the slide rail in the frontmost position. Remove the track adjusting handle.
Screwdriver
Seat Track
Handle
Stopper
Track Adjusting Handle
B70385
32.
(a)
33.
(a)
34.
(a)
(b)
35.
(a)
36.
(a)
37.
(a)
38.
(a)
39.
INSTALL FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.1
Install the cushion frame with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL FOLD SEAT CUSHION FRAME NO.2
Install the cushion frame with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK FRAME SUB-ASSY LOWER LH
Outer side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), install the 3 torx bolts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
Inner side:
Using a torx socket wrench (T55), install the seatback frame with the 2 torx bolts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK FRAME ASSY RH
Using a torx socket wrench (T40), install the seatback frame with the 4 torx bolts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR BACK LOCK CONTROL LEVER SUB-ASSY RH
Install the control lever with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL SEAT TRACK STOP PLATE RH
Install the stop plate with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL RECLINING CONTROL LINK SUB-ASSY RH
Install the control link with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 42 N⋅m (428 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR SEAT BELT ASSY INNER (See page 61-15 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3667
72-59
SEAT
-
REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (W/REAR NO.2 SEAT)
40.
(a)
Hog Ring Pliers
B50126
INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEATBACK COVER
Using hog ring pliers, install the seatback cover to the
seatback pad with new hog rings.
(b) Install the seatback cover to the seatback frame.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent
wrinkles as much as possible.
(c) Install the 2 headrest supports.
41. INSTALL SEPARATE TYPE REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Using hog ring pliers, install the cushion cover to the cushion pad with new hog rings.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
When installing the hog rings, take care to prevent wrinkles as much as possible.
(b) Install the cushion cover to the cushion frame.
42. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSY RH
(a) Using a torx socket wrench (T45), install seat cushion with the 2 torx bolts.
Torque: 21 N⋅m (214 kgf⋅cm, 15 ft⋅lbf) for hinge side
(b) Install the seat cushion with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18 N⋅m (184 kgf⋅cm, 13 ft⋅lbf) for cushion side
43. INSTALL REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH
(a) Place the seat in the cabin.
(b) Install the seat with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 36.7 N⋅m (375 kgf⋅cm, 27 ft⋅lbf)
(c) Install the fold seat stopper band with the bolt on the vehicle side.
Torque: 9.0 N⋅m (92 kgf⋅cm, 80 in.⋅lbf)
(d) Install the headrest.
(e) When sliding the seat, check that both sides of the adjuster lock simultaneously.
HINT:
Check that the seat adjuster locks.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3668
72-68
SEAT
-
SEAT HEATER SYSTEM
720RO-01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
Seat Heater (Front) Switch LH
B51466
INSPECT SEAT HEATER (FRONT) SWITCH LH
Check the resistance between the terminals when the
switch is operated.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
3-4
ON
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the seat heater switch.
(b) Push the seat heater switch ON and check that the seat
heater switch indicator illuminates.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 3
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 6
ON
Illuminates
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch or bulb.
(c) Check that the seat heater switch indicator illuminates.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 2
Illuminates
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch or bulb.
2.
(a)
Seat Heater (Front) Switch RH
B51467
INSPECT SEAT HEATER (FRONT) SWITCH RH
Check the resistance between the terminals when the
switch is operated.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
3-4
ON
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the seat heater switch.
(b) Push the seat heater switch ON and check that the seat
heater switch indicator illuminates.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 3
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 6
ON
Illuminates
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch or bulb.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3677
72-69
SEAT
(c)
-
SEAT HEATER SYSTEM
Check that the seat heater switch indicator illuminates
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 2
Illuminates
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch or bulb.
1
3.
(a)
5
3
5
2
3
1
2
INSPECT SEAT HEATER RELAY
Check the resistance of the relay.
Standard:
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
B68834
4.
A
(a)
INSPECT SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION
COVER LH
Apply battery voltage and check the seat cushion heater.
(1) Check the seat cushion heater.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal A2
Battery negative (-) → Terminal B1
Seat cushion heater becomes warm
If the result is not as specified, replace the seat cushion cover.
NOTICE:
After confirming that the seat heater is functioning normally, immediately remove the battery leads. Failing to do so
will cause the seat heater to overheat.
(2) Check the thermostat.
(b) Apply battery voltage and check the seat cushion heater.
(1) Check the thermostat.
Standard:
B
B78186
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal A4
Battery negative (-) → Terminal B6
Seat cushion heater temperature below
44C (111F)
If the temperature of the seat heater rises above the specified
value, replace the seat cushion cover.
NOTICE:
After confirming that the seat heater is functioning normally, immediately remove the battery leads. Failing to do so
will cause the seat heater to overheat.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3678
72-70
SEAT
5.
A
(a)
-
SEAT HEATER SYSTEM
INSPECT SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEAT CUSHION
COVER RH
Apply battery voltage and check the seat cushion heater.
(1) Check the seat cushion heater.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal A2
Battery negative (-) → Terminal A1
Seat cushion heater becomes warm
If the result is not as specified, replace the seat cushion cover.
NOTICE:
After confirming that the seat heater is functioning normally, immediately remove the battery leads. Failing to do so
will cause the seat heater to overheat.
(b) Apply battery voltage and check the seat cushion heater.
(1) Check the thermostat.
Standard:
B
B78186
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal B4
Battery negative (-) → Terminal B6
Seat cushion heater temperature below
44C (111F)
If the temperature of the seat heater rises above the specified
value, replace the seat cushion cover.
NOTICE:
After confirming that the seat heater is functioning normally, immediately remove the battery leads. Failing to do so
will cause the seat heater to overheat.
6.
INSPECT SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEATBACK
COVER
(a) Apply battery voltage and check the seatback heater.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 2
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Seatback heater becomes warm
If the result is not as specified, replace the seatback cover.
NOTICE:
After confirming that the seat heater is functioning normally, immediately remove the battery leads. Failing to do so
will cause the seat heater to overheat.
B78185
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3679
72-71
SEAT
7.
(a)
-
SEAT HEATER SYSTEM
INSPECT SEPARATE TYPE FRONT SEATBACK
COVER
Apply battery voltage and check the seat cushion heater.
Standard:
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 2
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Seat cushion heater becomes warm
If the result is not as specified, replace the seatback cover.
NOTICE:
After confirming that the seat heater is functioning normally, immediately remove the battery leads. Failing to do so
will cause the seat heater to overheat.
B78185
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3680
72-66
SEAT
-
SEAT HEATER SYSTEM
SEAT HEATER SYSTEM
720RM-01
LOCATION
Seat Heater (Front) Switch RH
Seat Heater (Front) Switch LH
R/B Sub-assy
Seat Heater Relay
Seatback Heater Assy RH
Instrument Panel J/B Assy
SEAT HTR Fuse
IG1 Fuse
Seat Cushion Heater Assy RH
Seat Cushion Heater Assy LH
Seatback Heater Assy LH
B78187
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3675
72-67
SEAT
-
SEAT HEATER SYSTEM
720RN-01
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspected Area
See Page
Driver’s and passenger’s seat heaters do not warm up
1.
2.
3.
4.
72-68
72-68
Only driver’s seat heater does not warm up
1. Seat heater (front) switch LH
2. Front seat cushion Cover LH
(seat cushion heater assy LH)
3. Front seatback cover LH
(seatback heater assy LH)
4. Wire harness
1. Seat heater (front) switch RH
2. Front seat cushion Cover RH
(seat cushion heater assy RH)
3. Front seatback cover RH
(seatback heater assy RH)
4. Wire harness
72-68
72-68
Only passenger’s seat heater does not warm up
SEAT HTR fuse
IG1 fuse
Seat heater relay
Wire harness
72-66
72-66
72-68
-
72-68
-
72-68
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3676
73-3
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
7302D-02
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
2
1
6 5 4 3
INSPECT DOOR CONTROL SWITCH ASSY
Inspect the door control switch continuity.
Switch position
Tester connection
Lock
3-6
Specified condition
Continuity
OFF
-
No continuity
Unlock
3-5
Continuity
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
B51554
2.
(a)
Unlock
INSPECT FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSY RH
Inspect the door lock assembly continuity.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
Lock
3-5
Continuity
OFF
-
No continuity
Unlock
4-5
Continuity
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
OFF
Lock
B51543
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3683
73-4
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
(b)
Unlock
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Inspect operation of the door lock motor.
Measurement condition
Operation
Battery positive - Terminal 1
Battery negative - Terminal 2
Lock
Battery positive - Terminal 2
Battery negative - Terminal 1
Unlock
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
(c) Inspect the position switch continuity.
Lock
Measurement condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Battery positive Terminal 2
Battery negative Terminal 1
5-6
Continuity
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
B51544
3.
(a)
Unlock
INSPECT FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSY LH
Inspect the door lock assembly continuity.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
Lock
2-4
Continuity
OFF
-
No continuity
Unlock
2-3
Continuity
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
OFF
Lock
B51545
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3684
73-5
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
(b)
Unlock
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Inspect operation of the door lock motor.
Measurement condition
Operation
Battery positive - Terminal 5
Battery negative - Terminal 6
Lock
Battery positive - Terminal 6
Battery negative - Terminal 5
Unlock
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
(c) Inspect the position switch continuity.
Lock
Measurement condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Battery positive Terminal 6
Battery negative Terminal 5
1-2
Continuity
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
B51546
4.
(a)
Unlock
INSPECT REAR DOOR LOCK ASSY RH
Inspect operation of the door lock motor.
Measurement condition
Operation
Battery positive - Terminal 1
Battery negative - Terminal 2
Lock
Battery positive - Terminal 2
Battery negative - Terminal 1
Unlock
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
(b) Inspect the position switch continuity.
Lock
Measurement condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Battery positive Terminal 2
Battery negative Terminal 1
3-4
Continuity
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
B51547
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3685
73-6
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
5.
(a)
Unlock
Lock
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT REAR DOOR LOCK ASSY LH
Inspect the operation of door lock motor.
Measurement condition
Operation
Battery positive - Terminal 1
Battery negative - Terminal 2
Lock
Battery positive - Terminal 2
Battery negative - Terminal 1
Unlock
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
(b) Inspect the position switch continuity.
Measurement condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Battery positive Terminal 2
Battery negative Terminal 1
1-2
Continuity
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
B51548
6.
(a)
Lock
INSPECT BACK DOOR LOCK ASSY
Inspect operation of the door lock motor.
Measurement condition
Operation
Battery positive - Terminal 4
Battery negative - Terminal 3
Lock
Battery positive - Terminal 3
Battery negative - Terminal 4
Unlock
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
(b) Inspect the back door courtesy switch continuity.
Unlock
Door lock latch position
Door Lock Motor
Specified condition
Open or Half Lock
Continuity
Closed
No continuity
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
Courtesy Switch
2 1
B51571
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3686
73-2
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
7302C-02
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
DOOR LOCK FAIL-SAFE
When a malfunction in the door control switch (manual switch, operation interlocked with key) has been
detected, door LOCK/UNLOCK operation become disabled.
2.
CHECK ELECTRICAL DOOR LOCK OPERATION
(a) Check the basic function.
(1) Check that all doors lock when the door control switch (for manual operation) is turned to LOCK
and all doors unlock when turned to UNLOCK.
(2) Check that all doors lock when the driver side door lock key cylinder is turned to LOCK and all
doors unlock when turned to UNLOCK from outside the vehicle.
(b) Check the key confinement prevention function.
NOTICE:
In order to prevent the key from being locked-in, the inspection should be made with the driver side
door glass open.
(1) Insert the key into the ignition key cylinder.
(2) With the driver side door open, check that all doors unlock immediately after the door lock knob
for the driver side door is turned to LOCK.
(3) With the driver side door open, check that all doors unlock immediately after the door control
switch (for manual operation) is turned to LOCK.
(4) With the driver side door open, turn the driver side door lock knob to LOCK and hold it for 2 seconds or more, and then close the driver side door. Then, check that all doors unlock.
(c) Check the security function.
(1) Close all doors with the driver side door glass open so that the door control switch can be operated from outside the vehicle.
(2) Pull out the key, open the driver side door, and close and lock the door without using the key.
Under this condition, check that all doors do not unlock when the door control switch (for manual
operation) is turned to UNLOCK from outside the vehicle.
(3) Pull out the key, close and lock the driver side door by key operation. Under this condition, check
that all doors do not unlock when the door control switch (for manual operation) is turned to UNLOCK from outside the vehicle.
(4) Pull out the key, close the driver side door and lock the door by wireless door lock operation. Under this condition, check that all doors do not unlock when the door control switch (for manual
operation) is turned to UNLOCK from outside the vehicle.
HINT:
Check that the security function is canceled under the conditions below:
The ignition switch is turned ON.
The driver side door is unlocked using the key.
The door control switch (for manual operation) is turned to UNLOCK after the door control knob is
turned to UNLOCK manually.
The doors are unlocked by wireless operation.
(d) Check the illumination function.
(1) Set the room light switch in the DOOR position.
(2) With all doors locked, check that all doors unlock when the driver side door lock cylinder is turned
to UNLOCK using the key. At the same time, the room light comes on.
(3) The room light goes off in approximately 15 seconds if doors have not been opened for a while.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3682
73-1
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
7302B-02
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
NOTICES FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OPERATION
When performing operation related to the door lock system and door lock key cylinder, be sure to disconnect the battery terminal or the connector of the window regulator motor.
CAUTION:
Operation is performed with the connectors being connected, the door control switch inside the door
lock might be activated, which results in unexpected injury.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3681
73-8
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
7302F-02
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
INSPECT WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL FUNCTION
Check the basic function.
(1) In the remote control operational area, check that all the doors lock or unlock when the switch
has been pressed for approximately 1 second. However, this will not happen when the key is in
the ignition key cylinder or any of the doors is open.
Check the automatic locking function.
(1) Check that all doors lock automatically as long as none of the doors have been opened or all
doors have not been locked within approximately 30 seconds after all doors are unlocked by
pressing the switch.
(2) Under the above condition, check that the automatic locking function does not operate when any
of the doors has been opened or all doors have been locked within approximately 30 seconds
after all doors are unlocked by pressing the switch.
Check the switch operation fail-safe function.
(1) Check that doors can not be locked or unlocked by the switch while the key is in the ignition key
cylinder. However, this does not apply when the system is in the recognition code registration
mode.
(2) Check that doors can not be locked or unlocked by the switch of an unregistered transmitter.
Check the chattering prevention function.
(1) Check that the corresponding operation occurs only once, and not repeated continuously while
the switch is kept pressed. However, when the switch is operated repeatedly at one second intervals, check that the corresponding operation is carried out.
Check the repeat function.
(1) Check that all doors attempt to automatically lock once again, 2 second after the lock switch has
been pressed while the movement of the driver side door control knob, which is in the unlocked
state, is being restricted.
Check the operation stop function when a door is open or not completely closed.
(1) Check that doors are not locked or unlocked by the switch while the doors are open or not completely closed.
Check the hazard flashing and buzzer sounding function (answer-back).
(1) Check that the hazard lights flash and also the buzzer sounds once (when locked) or twice (when
unlocked) simultaneously with locking or unlocking operation of all doors, when the switch is
pressed.
Check the room light on function.
(h)
HINT:
Move the room light switch in the DOOR position befor the check.
(1) Check that the room light will be on simultaneously with the unlocking operation when the switch
has been pressed for 1 second
(2) Check that the room light will be off in approximately 15 seconds if doors have not been opened
after the unlocking operation.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3688
73-9
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
2.
(a)
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRELESS CONTROL RECEIVER
Disconnect the receiver connector and check that the
connector on the wire harness side.
B51174
Continuity and Voltage:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 - Body ground
Constant
Continuity
5 - Body ground
Constant
10 - 14 V
HINT:
If the value is not as specified the vehicle’s side may be defective.
(b) Connect the receiver connector and check that the voltage using an oscilloscope.
Voltage:
Tester connection
1 - Body ground
Condition
Specified condition
All door is closed → Door control transmitter ON
0V→6V→0V
HINT:
If the result is not as specified, there may be a malfunction on the vehicle side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3689
73-7
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
7302E-02
PRECAUTION
HINT:
The switch described in this text indicates the switch for transmitting signals, which is built in the door control
transmitter.
1.
NOTE WHEN CHECKING
(a) The wireless door lock remote control function operates only when the following 4 conditions are satisfied.
(1) All the doors are closed.
(2) No key is inserted in the ignition key cylinder.
(3) The power door lock operates normally.
(4) The receiving function is not cancelled by the security function.
(b) The wireless door lock remote control function operational area.
(1) The operational area differs depending on the operator and the way the transmitter is held.
(2) In some places, the operational area will be reduced due to the vehicle body shape and the influence of the surrounding environment, or the remote control function will only operate partially.
(3) Because the transmitter uses faint electric waves, strong electric waves or noise in the frequency
used may reduce the operational area or the remote control may not function.
(4) When the battery weakens, the operational area is reduced or the remote control may not be
operated.
HINT:
If the door control transmitter has been left in a place that is exposed to the direct sunlight, such as on the
instrument panel, it may cause the battery to weaken or other trouble.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3687
73-10
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
TRANSMITTER BATTERY
TRANSMITTER BATTERY
730KH-01
REPLACEMENT
1.
REMOVE TRANSMITTER BATTERY
NOTICE:
Special caution should be taken when handling each component as they are precise electronic components.
(a) Using a coin or equivalent, open the transmitter case.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly apart the cover.
B79371
(b)
B79372
2.
Remove the discharged transmitter battery by ballpoint
pen. Insert the tip of ballpoint pen at the guide groove and
lift as shown in the left illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not push the terminals with your finger.
Do not forcibly pry up the battery (lithium battery).
The terminals may become damaged.
Do not touch the battery with wet hands. Water may
cause rust.
Do not touch or move any components inside the
transmitter, as it may cease to work.
INSTALL TRANSMITTER BATTERY
(a)
Put a new transmitter battery with positive (+) side up.
Close the transmitter case securely.
NOTICE:
Be sure that the positive side and the negative side of
the transmitter battery are matched up correctly.
Be careful not to bend the transmitter battery electrode during insertion.
Keep the transmitter case interior free of dust and oil.
B79373
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3690
73-14
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
7302I-04
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
B51553
INSPECT DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
Check operation of the registration of recognition code
(See page 73-1 1).
Inspect operation of the transmitter.
(1) Using a screwdriver, remove the cover.
(2) Remove the battery (lithium battery).
(3) Install a new or normal battery (lithium battery).
HINT:
When a new or normal battery is not available, connect 2 new
1.5 V batteries in series, connect the battery positive (+) to the
battery receptacle side terminal and battery negative (-) to the
bottom terminal, and then apply 3 V to the transmitter.
(4) In the location which is approximately 1 m away
from the driver’s outside handle in the right direction, check transmitter operation when pressing
transmission switch on the transmitter.
Standard: Remote control of vehicle door lock can be
operated.
HINT:
The minimum operation distance differs depending on to
the operator, the way the transmitter is held, and location.
Because the transmitter uses faint electric waves, strong
electric waves or noise in the frequency used may reduce
the operational area or the remote control may not function.
Install the battery (lithium battery).
Install the cover.
(c) Check the battery capacity.
HINT:
Make sure to use the TOYOTA electrical tester.
With the battery unloaded, whether the battery is available or not can not be judged by the test.
If the transmitter is faulty, the energy amount left in the
battery might not be checked correctly.
On the lithium battery used for the transmitter, the voltage
more than 2.5 V with the battery unloaded is shown on the
tester until the energy is completely consumed.
Therefore, when inspecting the energy amount left in the
battery, it is necessary to measure the voltage when the
battery is loaded (1.2 kΩ).
(1) Using a screwdriver, remove the screw and cover.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3694
73-15
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
(2)
(3)
DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
Remove the battery (lithium battery) from the transmitter.
Connect the lead to the negative (-) terminal of the
transmitter and install the battery.
B51551
(4)
Connect the positive (+) tester to the positive (+)
battery (lithium battery), and negative (-) tester to
the lead respectively.
(5) Press one of the transmission switches on the
transmitter for approximately 1 second.
(6) Press the transmission switch on the transmitter
again to check the voltage.
Standard: 2.1 V or more
B51552
HINT:
When the temperature of the battery is low, the judgement
can not be made correctly.
When the outcome of the test is less than 2.1V, conduct
the test again after leaving the battery in a place at 18°C
for more than 30 minutes.
By automatic power-off function, the voltage becomes no
load voltage (more than 2.5 V) condition after 20 seconds
from the switch has pressed. Make sure to read the voltage before it.
High voltage might be shown 1 or 2 times after leaving the
battery, judgement should be made with the voltage
shown at the 3rd time or later.
(7) Disconnect the lead.
(8) Set the battery (lithium battery) in the transmitter.
(9) Install the cover, so that the O-ring is not distorted
or slipped off.
(10) Using a screwdriver, tighten the screw.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3695
73-1 1
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
7302H-02
REPLACEMENT
1.
REGISTRATION OF RECOGNITION CODE
HINT:
The add mode is used to register a new recognition codes while still retaining codes already registered.
This mode is used to add a new transmitter. If the number of registered codes exceeds 4, the previously
registered codes will be erased in order, starting from the first registered code.
The rewrite mode is used to erase all the previously registered codes in order to register all new recognition codes. This mode is used to exchange the transmitter or the door control receiver for a new one.
The prohibition mode is used to erase all the registered codes and disables the wireless door lock function. Use this mode when the transmitter is lost.
The confirmation mode is used to confirm how many recognition codes have already been registered
before an additional registration of the recognition codes.
(a) Make sure that the vehicle fulfills the following conditions.
(1) No key is inserted in the ignition key cylinder.
(2) The driver side door is opened (The other doors are closed).
(3) The driver side door is unlocked.
(b) Select a mode.
(1) Insert the key into the ignition key cylinder, then pull it out (Perform this operation once again
within 5 seconds).
(2) Close and open the driver side door twice.
(3) Insert the key into the ignition key cylinder, then pull it out.
(4) Close and open the driver side door twice.
(5) Insert the key into the ignition key cylinder, then close the door.
(6) To select a mode, turn the ignition switch from ON to LOCK at approximately 1 second intervals
according to the number of times shown below. Then remove the key from the ignition key cylinder.
Add Mode
ON-LOCK change 1 time
Confirmation Mode
1 sec.
1 sec. 1 sec.
ON
ON
LOCK
LOCK
Rewrite Mode ON-LOCK change 2 times
Prohibition Mode ON-LOCK change 5 times
1 sec.1 sec.
ON
LOCK
ON-LOCK change 3 times
1 sec.1 sec.
ON
LOCK
B50826
NOTICE:
If the number of ON-LOCK operations of the ignition switch is 4 or more than 5, the registration
will end without any signs.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3691
73-12
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
(7)
-
DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
Within 3 seconds after a mode has been selected, the MPX ECU automatically performs LOCKUNLOCK operation to inform the operator which mode has been selected.
HINT:
When the confirmation mode has been selected and 0 codes are registered, LOCK-UNLOCK operation is automatically performed 5 times.
When the confirmation mode has been selected and LOCK-UNLOCK operation has been performed
twice as shown in the illustration below, the number of the registered recognition codes is 2.
Confirmation Mode
Add Mode
1st time
1 sec.
2nd time
2sec. 2 sec.
LOCK
LOCK
UNLOCK
UNLOCK
Rewrite Mode
Prohibition Mode
1sec. 1 sec
1 sec.1 sec.
LOCK
LOCK
UNLOCK
UNLOCK
B50827
HINT:
When the prohibition mode or the confirmation mode is selected, the registration mode ends.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3692
73-13
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
(c)
Register the transmitter.
(1) Within 40 seconds after the add mode or the rewrite mode has been selected, simultaneously
press the LOCK and UNLOCK switches for 1.0 to 1.5 seconds. Then press either one of the
switches for more than 1.0 second.
NOTICE:
Press and hold both switches for 1 second or more during each press. However, the time between
the 1st press and the 2nd press must be under 3 seconds.
(2) LOCK-UNLOCK operation is automatically performed once within 3 seconds after above operation (step 1), when the recognition code of the transmitter has been registered correctly. If the
LOCK-UNLOCK operation is performed twice, the registration of the recognition code has failed.
In this case, register the recognition code from the beginning of the registration procedures once
again.
LOCK-UNLOCK occurs once
Registration has been completed
Approx.
1 sec.
LOCK-UNLOCK occurs twice
Registration has failed
Approx. Approx.
1 sec.1 sec.
LOCK
LOCK
UNLOCK
UNLOCK
B50828
(3)
In order to continue in registration mode, start the next registration within 40 seconds after the
previous one.
HINT:
The maximum number of the recognition codes that can be registered is 4.
(d) If even one of the following conditions is satisfied, the registration mode will end.
(1) 40 seconds have elapsed under the condition that the registration mode is ready.
(2) The driver side door is opened.
(3) The key is inserted in the ignition key cylinder.
(4) 4 recognition codes are registered at once.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3693
73-16
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
730KG-01
REGISTRATION
1.
(a)
(b)
DESCRIPTION OF CODE REGISTRATION
When adding master keys and sub-keys (additional registration).
(1) Register the key code (immobilizer code) in the transponder key ECU.
See step
Transponder key ECU
3
When replacing the transponder key ECU (new registration).
(1) Register the key code (immobilizer code) in the transponder key ECU.
(2)
(c)
Target ECU
Target ECU
See step
Transponder key ECU
2
Register the ECU COMMUNICATION ID between the ECM and the transponder key ECU.
Target ECU
See step
ECM
5
When replacing the ECM.
(1) Register the ECU COMMUNICATION ID between the ECM and the transponder key ECU.
Target ECU
See step
Transponder key ECU
5
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3696
73-17
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
2.
(a)
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
KEY REGISTRATION IN AUTOMATIC REGISTRATION (NEW REGISTRATION)
When an ignition key is inserted into the ignition cylinder, the key code (immobilizer code) registration
is automatic. In this mode, a maximum of 4 key codes for 3 master keys and 1 sub-key can be registered. Any order of registration for the master keys and sub-keys is fine because the transponder key
ECU can distinguish between different types of keys.
HINT:
When a new transponder key ECU is installed, key codes (immobilizer codes) must be registered with
ignition keys.
New transponder key ECUs are automatically set to automatic key code registration mode.
Automatic Key Code Registration
(New Registration):
Security Indicator
START
BLINKING
(Until the first key is
inserted.)
Insert the key into the ignition key cylinder.
OFF
Registration begins.
(Approx. 1 second)
(The registration is completed approx. 1 second after the key is inserted.)
Remove the key.
ON
(When the maximum
number of key codes
are registered, the
security indicator re-
Yes
mains OFF until the
last key registered is
Register another key?
removed. After it is
removed, the security indicator starts
blinking.)
No
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3697
73-18
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
HINT:
When no key is inserted in the ignition key cylinder in automatic key code registration mode, the security indicator remains on.
When the immobilizer system is operating normally and the key is pulled out, the security indicator
blinks continuously.
If the key code registration has failed in automatic key code registration mode, code 2-1 will be output
from the security indicator. Trying to re-register an already registered key will cause code 2-2 to be
output when the key is inserted. If the number of registered key codes exceeds the limit, code 2-3 will
be output from the security indicator. The output details are shown below.
Security Indicator:
0.2 sec.
ON
Normal
(Immobilizer system is
operating normally.)
OFF
1.8 sec.
0.25 sec.
1 sec.
ON
Code 2-1
OFF
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
1 sec.
ON
Code 2-2
OFF
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
1 sec.
ON
Code 2-3
OFF
0.25 sec.
(b)
0.5 sec.
Finish the automatic key code registration mode.
The automatic key code registration mode can be forced to end when at least 1 key code (immobiliser
code) for the master key has been registered.
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON and OFF 5 times within 10 seconds using the already registered master key.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3698
73-19
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
3.
REGISTRATION OF ADDITIONAL KEY (ADDITIONAL REGISTRATION)
(a) Register an additional key by using the hand-held tester.
HINT:
A maximum of 5 master key codes and 3 sub-key codes can be registered.
Registration mode will end if each step is not completed within the specified time.
When the ignition cylinder or the key cylinder set is replaced, remove the transmitter module from the
original master key. Then install this transmitter module to a new key and use the new key as the master
key. If necessary, use this master key to register other keys.
NOTICE:
When the ignition key cylinder has been replaced, locking and unlocking doors is possible with the
new master key’s transmitter module (taken from the original master key). However, the new master
key will not be able to lock and unlock doors through the door key cylinder. Keep the original master
key. If the new master key’s transmitter module’s battery fails, the original master key can be used
to lock and unlock doors through the door key cylinder.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3699
73-20
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
Additional Registration
Security Indicator
START
BLINKING
(Until the first
key is inserted.)
Insert the already registered master key in the ignition key cylinder and
turn the ignition switch ON.
OFF
ON
Hand-held tester operation:
1. Select HIGHLANDER from the menu.
2. Select IMMOBILISER.
3. Select ID UTILITY.
4. Select TRANSP CODE REG.
After the above operation, proceed to the next step according to the
prompts on the tester screen.
Within 120 seconds
Within 20 seconds
after the tester
instruction
Remove the master key.
Within 10 seconds
Insert the key to be registered in the ignition key cylinder.
BLINKING
After 60 seconds, the key is registered.
(The security indicator goes off.)
OFF
END
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3700
73-21
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
HINT:
A brief outline of procedures for key code registration is shown on the previous page. For more detailed
information, please refer to the hand-held tester screen’s instructions.
When the immobilizer system is operating normally and the key is pulled out, the security indicator
blinks continuously.
If the key code registration has failed in automatic key code registration mode, code 2-1 will be output
from the security indicator. Trying to re-register an already registered key will cause code 2-2 to be
output when the key is inserted. If the number of registered key codes exceeds the limit, code 2-3 will
be output from the security indicator. The output details are shown in step 2 (new registration).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3701
73-22
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
4.
ERASURE OF KEY CODE
(a) Erase key codes using the hand-held tester.
HINT:
All key codes are erased except for the master key, which is used for erasing the key codes.
In order to use a key whose code has been erased, a new key code must be registered.
Registration will be cancelled if each step is not completed within the specified time.
Erasing Key Code
Security Indicator
START
BLINKING
(Until the first
key is inserted.)
OFF
ON for 1 second
then OFF
Insert the already registered master key in the ignition key cylinder
and turn the ignition switch ON.
Hand-held tester operation:
1. Select HIGHLANDER from the menu.
2. Select IMMOBILISER.
3. Select ID UTILITY.
4. Select TRANSP CODE ERS.
After the above operation, proceed to the next step in accordance
with the tester screen’s instructions.
Within 120 seconds
Within 10 seconds
after the tester
Remove the master key.
indicates
BLINKING
END
HINT:
A brief outline of procedures for key code registration is shown on this page. For more detailed information, please refer to the hand-held tester screen’s instructions.
When the immobilizer system is operating normally and the key is pulled out, the security indicator
blinks continuously.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3702
73-23
THEFT DETERRENT & DOOR LOCK
-
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
5.
ECU COMMUNICATION ID REGISTRATION
NOTICE:
The ECU communication ID should be registered when the transponder key ECU and/or the
ECM is replaced in order to match the ECM COMMUNICATION ID.
The engine cannot be started unless the ECM COMMUNICATION ID matches.
(a) Register the ECU communication ID.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON (do not start the engine) and leave it as is for 30 minutes.
(3) Turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect terminals TC and CG.
(4) Check that the engine starts.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3703
74-9
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF
SLIDING ROOF
740EF-01
COMPONENTS
Rear Floor
Finish Plate
Tonneau Cover Assy
Back Door
Weatherstrip
Deck Board
Sub-assy No. 2
Rear Door Opening
Trim Weatherstrip RH
Quarter Pillar
Garnish RH
Front Door Opening
Trim Weatherstrip RH
Roof Side Rail
Garnish Assy RH
Deck Board
Sub-assy No. 3
Deck Board
Sub-assy
Center Pillar
Garnish RH
Front Pillar
Garnish RH
Roof Side Garnish
Assy Inner RH
Deck Side
Trim Box RH
Deck Floor
Box Rear
Deck Trim Side
Panel Assy RH
Rear No. 1 Seat
Outer Belt Assy RH
42 (420, 31)
Front Door
Scuff Plate RH
Rear Door
Scuff Plate RH
Center Pillar
Garnish Lower RH
Front Seat Outer
Belt Assy RH
Deck Side
Trim Box LH
Roof Side Rail
Garnish Assy LH
Roof Side Garnish
Assy Inner LH
Rear No. 1 Seat
Outer Belt Assy LH
42 (420, 31)
Front Pillar
Garnish LH
Quarter Pillar
Garnish LH
Deck Floor
Box Front
Center Pillar
Garnish LH
Front Seat Outer
Belt Assy LH
Deck Trim Side
Panel Assy LH
Front Door Opening
Trim Weatherstrip LH
Rear Door
Scuff Plate LH
Front Door Scuff Plate LH
Center Pillar
Garnish Lower LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
Rear Door Opening
Trim Weatherstrip LH
: Specified torque
B77611
Author:
Date:
3712
74-10
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF
w/ Rear No. 2 Seat
Rear Floor Finish Plate
Deck Board
Sub-assy No.2
Roof Side Rail
Garnish Sub-assy RH
Roof Side Garnish
Assy Inner RH
Rear No. 2 Seat
Outer Belt Assy RH
Deck Board
Sub-assy
Deck Side
Trim Box RH
Quarter Pillar
Garnish RH
Deck Board
Sub-assy No.3
Deck Floor
Box Rear
42 (420, 31)
Roof Side Rail Garnish
Sub-assy LH
Rear No. 2 Seat
Outer Belt Assy LH
Deck Side
Trim Box LH
Deck Trim Side
Panel Assy RH
Roof Side Garnish
Assy Inner LH
Quarter Pillar Garnish LH
Rear Door
Scuff Plate RH
Rear Door
Scuff Plate LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
Deck Trim Side
Panel Assy LH
: Specified torque
B77612
Author:
Date:
3713
74-10-1
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF
Roof Silencer Pad No. 1
Sun Roof Opening
Trim Moulding
Roof Silencer Pad No. 4
Roof Silencer Pad No. 5
Room Lamp
Assy No. 2
Assist Grip
Sub-assembly
Roof Headlining Assy
RH Visor Assy
Assist Grip
Sub-assy
Assist Grip
Sub-assy
Room Lamp
Assy No. 1
Visor Holder
Roof Console
Box Assy
Visor Holder
LH Visor Assy
B82237
Author:
Date:
3714
74-10-2
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF
Sliding Roof Side Garnish RH
Sliding Roof Glass Sub-assy
Sliding Roof Side Garnish LH
5.5 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Sunshade Trim Assy
Sliding Roof Housing Center
Mounting Bracket RH
Sliding Roof Panel Stopper
Sliding Roof Housing Front
Mounting Bracket RH
Drain Hose
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Sliding Roof Panel Stopper
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Drain Hose
5.5 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Sliding Roof Drive
Gear Assy
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
5.5 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Sliding Roof Housing Center
Mounting Bracket LH
Drain Hose
Sliding Roof Drive
Gear Bracket
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
Sliding Roof Housing Front
Mounting Bracket LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.⋅lbf)
B93084
Author:
Date:
3715
74-10-3
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF
Sliding Roof Drive Cable
5.5 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
5.5 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Sliding Roof Rail
Roof Wind Deflector Panel Assy
Sliding Roof Housing Panel
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
B93085
Author:
Date:
3716
74-10-4
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF
740EG-01
OVERHAUL
1.
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY TERMINAL
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSY (See page 76-21 )
3.
(a)
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF SIDE GARNISH RH
Using a screwdriver, detach the 4 claws and remove the
garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B93086
4.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF SIDE GARNISH LH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the RH side.
5.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF GLASS SUB-ASSY
(a) Using a T25 ”torx” driver, remove the 4 screws and glass.
(b) Pull the glass upward to remove it.
6.
(a)
DISCONNECT SLIDING ROOF DRAIN HOSE
Disconnect the 4 drain hoses.
B93087
7.
8.
REMOVE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG RH (w/ Curtain Shield Airbag) (See page 60-38 )
REMOVE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG LH (w/ Curtain Shield Airbag) (See page 60-38 )
9.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT SIDE RAIL SPACER RH (w/o Curtain
Shield Airbag)
Detach the 3 claws and remove the rail spacer.
B93088
Author:
Date:
3717
74-10-5
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF
10. REMOVE FRONT SIDE RAIL SPACER LH (w/o Curtain Shield Airbag)
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the RH side.
11.
(a)
REMOVE REAR SIDE RAIL SPACER RH (w/o Curtain
Shield Airbag)
Detach the 4 claws and remove the rail spacer.
B93089
12. REMOVE REAR SIDE RAIL SPACER LH (w/o Curtain Shield Airbag)
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the RH side.
13. REMOVE SLIDING ROOF HOUSING FRONT MOUNTING BRACKET RH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and bracket.
14. REMOVE SLIDING ROOF HOUSING FRONT MOUNTING BRACKET LH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the RH side.
15. REMOVE SLIDING ROOF HOUSING CENTER MOUNTING BRACKET RH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and bracket.
16. REMOVE SLIDING ROOF HOUSING CENTER MOUNTING BRACKET LH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the RH side.
17.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF HOUSING SUB-ASSY
Disconnect the drive gear connector.
Remove the 8 nuts and roof housing.
B93090
18.
(a)
(b)
19.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF DRIVE GEAR SUB-ASSY
Remove the bracket.
Remove the 2 bolts and drive gear.
REMOVE SUNSHADE TRIM SUB-ASSY
Remove the 2 stoppers.
Slide and remove the sunshade trim.
Author:
Date:
3718
74-10-6
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
20.
-
SLIDING ROOF
(a)
REMOVE ROOF WIND DEFLECTOR
SUB-ASSY
Using a screwdriver, slide the drive cable.
PANEL
(b)
Detach the claw, and remove the deflector panel.
21.
(a)
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF HOUSING PANEL
Remove the screw and housing panel.
B93091
B93092
B93093
22. REMOVE SLIDING ROOF DRIVE CABLE
(a) Using a screwdriver, slide the drive cables backward and remove them.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
23. INSTALL SLIDING ROOF DRIVE CABLE
24. ADJUST FULLY CLOSED POSITION
(a) Using a screwdriver, slide the sliding roof drive cable LH
and RH to align the matchmaks.
Matchmark
HINT:Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B93094
25.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SLIDING ROOF HOUSING PANEL
Engage the 2 claws.
Install the housing panel with the 2 screws.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Author:
Date:
3719
74-10-7
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
26.
(a)
27.
(a)
(b)
28.
(a)
(b)
29.
(a)
(b)
30.
(a)
-
SLIDING ROOF
INSTALL ROOF WIND DEFLECTOR PANEL SUB-ASSY
Engage the claw, and install the deflector panel.
INSTALL SUNSHADE TRIM SUB-ASSY
Insert the sunshade trim into the sliding roof housing.
Install the 2 stoppers.
INSTALL SLIDING ROOF DRIVE GEAR SUB-ASSY
Install the drive gear with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
Install the bracket to the drive gear.
INSTALL SLIDING ROOF HOUSING SUB-ASSY
Install the roof housing with the 8 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
Connect the drive gear connector.
INSTALL SLIDING ROOF HOUSING CENTER MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Install the bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL SLIDING ROOF HOUSING CENTER MOUNTING BRACKET LH
31.
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the RH side.
32. INSTALL SLIDING ROOF HOUSING FRONT MOUNTING BRACKET RH
(a) Install the bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
33. INSTALL SLIDING ROOF HOUSING FRONT MOUNTING BRACKET LH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the RH side.
34. CONNECT SLIDING ROOF DRAIN HOSE
(a) Connect the 4 drain hoses.
35.
(a)
C
A
C B
A
D
B
(b)
D
a
INSTALL SLIDING ROOF GLASS SUB-ASSY
Using a T25 ”torx driver, temporarily install the sliding roof
glass with the 4 screws.”
Perform a level check.
Check the difference in level for ”a” between the roof panel and the upper surface of the weatherstrip when the sliding roof glass is fully closed.
Standard measurement
Area
Specified Condition
A-A
0 + 1.00 - 2.0 mm
0 + 0.0039 - 0.0079 in.
B-B
0 + 2.00 - 1.0 mm
0 + 0.0079 - 0.0039 in.
C-C
0 1.5 mm
0 0.0059 in.
D-D
0 + 1.50 - 1.0 mm
0 + 0.0059 - 0.0039 in.
B93095
Author:
Date:
3720
74-10-8
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF
(c)
Perform a gap check.
Check the gap between the roof panel and roof glass.
NOTICE:
The gap must be even all around.
(d) Using a T25 ”torx” driver, install the sliding roof glass with
the 4 screws.
Even
B93096
36. INSTALL SLIDING ROOF SIDE GARNISH RH
(a) Attach the 4 claws to install the garnish.
37. INSTALL SLIDING ROOF SIDE GARNISH LH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the RH side.
38. CHECK FOR WATER LEAKS
(a) Adjust the sliding roof glass, and check for water leaks.
(b) If there are any leaks, readjust the sliding roof glass.
39. INSTALL REAR SIDE RAIL SPACER RH (w/o Curtain Shield Airbag)
(a) Attach the 4 claws to install the rail spacer.
40. INSTALL REAR SIDE RAIL SPACER LH (w/o Curtain Shield Airbag)
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the RH side.
41. INSTALL FRONT SIDE RAIL SPACER RH (w/o Curtain Shield Airbag)
(a) Attach the 3 claws to install rail spacer.
42. INSTALL FRONT SIDE RAIL SPACER LH (w/o Curtain Shield Airbag)
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the RH side.
43. INSTALL CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG RH (w/ Curtain Shield Airbag) (See page 60-38 )
44. INSTALL CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG LH (w/ Curtain Shield Airbag) (See page 60-38 )
45. INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSY (See page 76-21 )
46. CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY TERMINAL
Author:
Date:
3721
74-5
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
740EC-01
DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
CHECK USING INTELLIGENT TESTER
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Select the DATA LIST mode on the intelligent tester.
Sliding roof ECU:
Item
Switch condition
Standard value
OPEN SW
Pressed → Unpressed
ON/OFF
CLOSE SW
Pressed → Unpressed
ON/OFF
Position detection SW 1
Do sliding and tilting operation
ON/OFF
Position detection SW 2
Do sliding and tilting operation
ON/OFF
HALL IC condition
Do sliding and tilting operation
Normal/ Abnormal
HALL IC out put
Do sliding and tilting operation
ON/OFF
IG
Ignition Switch ON → OFF
ON/OFF
IG line signal
Ignition Switch ON → OFF
ON/OFF
Operation possible after key-OFF
Ignition Switch ON → OFF
ON/OFF
The active test will indicate if the part is normal or malfunctioning.
Sliding roof ECU:
Item
Condition
Sliding Roof
CLOSE/ UP
Sliding Roof
OPEN/DOWN
Author:
Date:
3708
74-2
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
740E9-01
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedures on the following pages.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
(a)
(b)
If the symptom does not occur, proceed to A.
If the symptom occurs, proceed to B.
A
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
B
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOM TABLE
5
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
6
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
7
REPAIR OR REPLACE
8
CONFIRMATION TEST
END
Author:
Date:
3705
74-8
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
740EE-01
INSPECTION
O5
1.
(a)
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF SWITCH ASSY
Disconnect the sliding roof switch connector, and check
the voltage or continuity of each terminal of the connector.
B78737
Standard
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring color
Condition
Specified condition
UP (O5 - 6) ⇔ Body ground
G⇔ -
Each switch OFF
Continuity
DOWN (O5 - 4) ⇔ Body ground
W⇔ -
Each switch OFF
Continuity
UP (O5 - 6) ⇔ Body ground
DOWN (O5 - 4) ⇔ Body ground
G⇔ -
Ignition switch ON
Sliding roof fully closed
Slide open switch OFF → ON
(Slide open side)
0 V → 10 to 14 V
W⇔ -
Ignition switch ON
Sliding roof fully closed
Slide open switch OFF → ON
(Slide open side)
0 V → 10 to 14 V
IG (O5 - 9) ⇔ Body ground
GR ⇔ -
Ignition switch ON
0 V → 10 to 14 V
GND (O5 - 1) ⇔ Body ground
W-B⇔ -
Constant
Continuity
Author:
Date:
3711
74-6
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
740ED-01
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK AUTO OPERATION
HINT:
When pressing the switch for 0.3 seconds or less, the roof glass moves but auto operation does not operate.
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) When the roof glass is fully closed, check that pressing the slide roof open side of the sliding roof switch
for 0.3 seconds or more causes the roof glass to slide and stop at the fully open position.
HINT:
If the slide open side of the sliding roof switch is pressed again, the roof glass will move 45 mm beyond the
stored fully open position.
(c) When the roof glass is fully open, check that pressing the tilt up side of the sliding roof switch for 0.3
seconds or more causes the roof glass to slide to the fully closed position.
(d) When the roof glass is for 0.3 seconds or more causes the roof glass to tilt to the fully tilted up position.
fully closed, check that pressing the tilt up side of the sliding switch
(e) When roof glass is fully tilted up, check that pressing the slide open side of the sliding roof switch for
0.3 seconds or more causes the roof glass to tilt to the fully tilted down position.
(f)
During auto function operation (slide open/ close, tilt up/down), check that operating the sliding roof
switch stops the roof glass.
2.
CHECK SLIDING ROOF OPERATION AFTER IGNITION SWITCH IS TURNED OFF (KEY-OFF OPERATION)
(a) Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF, and check that the sliding roof operates. Then open the driver
side door once, and check that the sliding roof does not operate.
(b) Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF and wait for approximately 43 seconds. Check that the sliding
roof does not operate.
(c) Operate the auto (SLIDE OPEN or TILT UP) operation. While the roof glass is in motion, turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Check that the auto operation continues until the roof glass opens or closes
fully. After the auto operation is completed, check that the sliding roof operation cannot be performed.
3.
CHECK JAM PROTECTION FUNCTION (Overload Reverse Operation)
CAUTION:
Do not use a part of your body, for example, your hand, to check the jam protection.
Do not allow anything to become caught in the sliding roof by accident in this procedure.
Perform the inspection from the inside of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Do not use hand objects, such as a hammer, to avoid damage to the roof.
If the jam protection does not operate, reset the sliding roof drive gear (motor).
HINT:
The jam protection function operates in any of the following condition:
AUTO operation
MANUAL operation
Sliding close or tiling down roof glass by AUTO operation after key-off operation
Author:
Date:
3709
74-7
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
(a)
When the sliding roof auto operation is operating and an
object is caught between the vehicle body and glass,
check that the roof glass opens a distance of 115 mm
(4.53 in.) from the point of contact with the object, or
opens fully if an opening distance of 115 mm (4.53 in.) is
not available (the maximum operation duration: 20 seconds).
(b)
When the TILT UP DOWN function is operating, and an
object is caught between the vehicle body and the roof
glass, check that the sliding roof tilts up fully, or tilts up for
2 seconds.
(c)
After the jam protection function operates, check that the
roof glass closes fully by the manual operation when the
TILT UP switch is pressed for 10 seconds or more.
B68295
B68296
Author:
Date:
3710
74-1
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
740E8-01
LOCATION
Sliding Roof Housing
Sliding Roof Drive Gear Sub-assy
(Sliding Roof ECU)
Sliding Roof Motor Switch
B93077
Author:
Date:
3704
74-3
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
740EA-01
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Sliding roof system o
operates
erates abnormally.
Suspected area
See page
1. Slide roof control switch
74-8
2. Slide roof drive gear sub-assy
74-4
3. Wire harness
Sliding roof system stops
sto s operation
o eration halftra ed in
way. (No foreign materials are trapped
motor assy)
-
1. Slide roof control switch
74-8
2. Slide roof drive gear sub-assy
74-4
3. Wire harness
-
Author:
Date:
3706
74-4
SLIDING ROOF/CONVERTIBLE
-
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
740EB-01
TERMINALS OF ECU
S20
1.
(a)
CHECK SLIDING ROOF DRIVE GEAR SUB- ASSY
(SLIDING ROOF ECU)
Disconnect the sliding roof ECU connector, and check the
voltage or continuity of each terminal of the wire harness
side connector.
B31361
Symbols (terminal No.)
Wire color
Condition
Specified condition
ECUB (S20 - 5) - Body ground
B⇔ -
Constant
10 to 14 V
B (S20 - 7) - Body ground
L⇔ -
Constant
10 to 14 V
E (S20 - 7) - Body ground
W-B⇔ -
Constant
Continuity
If the result is not as specified, there may be a malfunction on
the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
3707
75-4
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
FRONT DOOR
750GT-04
ADJUSTMENT
HINT:
Before adjusting the door position for vehicles equipped with side airbags and curtain shield airbags,
be sure to disconnect the battery. After adjustment, inspect the SRS warning lamp, the side airbag
system and the curtain shield airbag system for normal operation. Then initialize both airbag systems.
Use the same procedure for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Centering Bolt
Centering bolts are used to mount the door hinge to the
vehicle body and door. The door cannot be adjusted with
the centering bolts on. Substitute the centering bolts with
standard bolts (w/ washers) when making adjustments.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
Standard Bolt
B79352
1.
(a)
INSPECT FRONT DOOR PANEL SUB-ASSY LH
Check that the value is within the standard value.
Standard
C
B
A: 3.0 to 6.0 mm (0.118 to 0.236 in.)
B: 3.8 to 6.8 mm (0.150 to 0.268 in.)
C: 3.8 to 6.8 mm (0.150 to 0.268 in.)
D: 3.5 to 6.5 mm (0.138 to 0.256 in.)
E: 3.5 to 6.5 mm (0.138 to 0.256 in.)
D
A
E
B51625
2.
(a)
ADJUST FRONT DOOR PANEL SUB-ASSY LH
Disconnected the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
CAUTION:
Work must be started 90 seconds after the ignition switch
is turned is the ”LOCK” position and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery. (The SRS is
equipped with a back-up power source so that if work is
started within 90 seconds from disconnecting the negative
(-) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS may be deployed.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3725
75-5
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
Body Side
(b)
Door Side
(c)
(d)
(e)
Body Side
(a)
-
FRONT DOOR
Using SST, adjust the door by loosening the body side
hinge bolts.
SST 09812-00010
Tighten the body side hinge bolts after the adjustment.
Torque: 23 N⋅m (235 kgf⋅cm, 17 ft⋅lbf)
Adjust the door by loosening the door side hinge bolts.
Tighten the door side hinge bolts after the adjustment.
Torque: 27 N⋅m (275 kgf⋅cm, 20 ft⋅lbf)
Door Side
(b)
B51540
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
Adjust the striker position by slightly loosening the striker
mounting screws and hitting the striker with a plastic hammer.
Tighten the striker mounting screws again.
Torque: 23 N⋅m (235 kgf⋅cm, 17 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable th the battery.
Initialize both airbag systems.
Inspect the SRS warning lamp (see page 05-1207 ).
B51396
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3726
75-3
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
FRONT DOOR
FRONT DOOR
7508N-04
COMPONENTS
Front Door Glass
Front Door Glass Run
Front Door Outside
Handle
Front Door Outside
Front Door
Key Cylinder
Handle Frame
Front Door Outside
Handle Cover
Front Door
Belt Moulding
Front Door Outside
Handle Rear Pad
Front Door Outside
Handle Pad
Front Door Frame
RR LWR
8.0 (82, 71 in.·lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.·lbf)
Outer Rear
View Mirror
Front Door
Lock Assy
23 (235, 17)
5.5 (56, 49 in.·lbf)
Front Door
Window Regulator
27 (275, 20)
Front Door Service
Hole Cover
5.5 (56, 49 in.·lbf)
Front Door Inside Handle
Front Door Inside
Handle Bezel
Front Door Lower Frame
Bracket Garnish
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
11 (112, 8)
5.4 (54, 48 in.·lbf)
Door Pull Handle
Power Window
Regulator Motor
Front Door Trim Board
B67989
B52498
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, in.⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B78827
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3724
75-6
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
FRONT DOOR
750UG-03
OVERHAUL
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
(a)
Clip
Claw
REMOVE MULTIPLEX NETWORK MASTER SWITCH
ASSY
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 5 claws and clip, remove the power window regulator master switch.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
Claw
B64830
Clip
2.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw and clip, remove
the front door lower frame bracket garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Claw
B51384
3.
(a)
Clip
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 clips and remove
the door pull handle.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B51528
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
Remove the screw.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 3 claws and remove
the door inside handle bezel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
:Claw
B52219
B78829
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3727
75-7
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
5.
(a)
(b)
-
FRONT DOOR
REMOVE FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the clip and screw.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 7 clips and remove
the trim board.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B51380
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE SUB-ASSY
LH
Remove the bolt and inside handle.
Disconnect the 2 cables from the door lock.
B51531
7.
8.
(a)
(b)
9.
(a)
(b)
10.
11.
12.
13.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
REMOVE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSY
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the bolt and speaker.
REMOVE OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY LH
Remove the 3 bolts.
Disconnect the connector and remove the mirror.
REMOVE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSY
REMOVE FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSY LH (See page 76-1 1)
REMOVE FRONT DOOR GLASS RUN LH
REMOVE FRONT DOOR FRAME SUB-ASSY REAR LOWER LH
Remove the bolt and door frame rear lower.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
B51532
14. REMOVE FRONT DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSY LH
HINT:
Insert a shop rag inside the door panel to prevent scratching the
glass.
(a) Open the door glass until the bolts appear in the service
hole.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and door glass.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the door glass.
HINT:
Pull the glass upward to remove it.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3728
75-8
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
15.
(a)
(b)
16.
(a)
17.
(a)
18.
19.
-
FRONT DOOR
REMOVE FRONT DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the 6 bolts.
Disconnect the connector, and then remove the front door window regulator.
REMOVE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY LH FRONT
Using a torx wrench (T25), remove the 3 screws and motor.
APPLY BODY GREASE
Apply MP grease to the sliding and rotating parts of the regulator.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSY LH
APPLY BODY GREASE
20.
(a)
(b)
(c)
B51386
21.
(a)
A
B
B52376
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE FRAME
SUB-ASSY LH
Using a torx wrench (T30), remove the 2 screws and
door lock cylinder.
Pushing the outside handle in the arrow mark direction as
shown in the illustration, remove the outside handle and
outside handle frame.
Using a torx wrench (T30), remove the screw and frame.
Torque: 4.0 N⋅m (41 kgf⋅cm, 36 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSY LH
Using a torx wrench (T30), install the door lock with the
4 screws.
Torque:
5.0 N⋅m (50 kgf⋅cm, 45 in.⋅lbf) for A
5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf) for B
Install the 2 bolts.
Connect the links to the outside handle.
Connect the connector.
22. INSTALL POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY LH FRONT
(a) If the jam protection function does not operate properly, perform the following procedure.
HINT:
It is necessary to reset the power window motor (in the initial position for the limit switch) when separating
the window regulator from the power window motor or operating the window regulator with the door glass
not installed.
(1) Remove the power window motor.
HINT:
Place the mactchmarks on the power window motor and window regulator gear.
(2) Connect the power window motor and power window switch to the wire harness of the vehicle.
(3) Turn the ignition switch ON and operate the power window motor in the power window up direction for more than 6 rotations or less than 10 rotations (4 seconds or more) using the power window switch.
(4) Assemble the power window motor and regulator.
HINT:
Install the motor when the regulator arm is below the middle point.
Align the matchmarks on the power window motor and window regulator gear when installing the power window motor.
(5) Assemble the power window regulator and door glass.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3729
75-9
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
FRONT DOOR
HINT:
Never rotate the motor in the power window’s down direction until the window glass is completely installed.
23. INSTALL FRONT DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR SUB-ASSY LH
(a) Install the window regulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 11.0 N⋅m (112 kgf⋅cm, 8 ft⋅lbf)
24. INSTALL FRONT DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Install a new service hole cover to the door panel.
HINT:
When installing the service hole cover, pull out the links
and connectors through the service hole cover.
There should be no wrinkles or folds after installing the
service hole cover.
After installing the service hole cover, check the sealing
condition.
B51534
25.
(a)
INSTALL OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSY LH
Install the mirror with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3730
75-1
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
HOOD
HOOD
750GS-03
ADJUSTMENT
HINT:
Standard Bolt
Centering Bolt
Use the same procedure for the RH side and LH side.
Centering bolts are used to mount the door hinge to the
vehicle body and door. The door cannot be adjusted with
the centering bolts on. Substitute the centering bolts with
standard bolts (w/ washers) when making adjustments.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
B77634
1.
(a)
INSPECT HOOD SUB-ASSY
Check that the clearance is within the standard value.
Standard
A
A: 4.0 (0.157)
mm (in.)
B52500
2.
(a)
ADJUST HOOD SUB-ASSY
Horizontally and vertically adjust the hood.
(1) Loosen the hood side hinge bolts.
(2) Adjust the clearance so that it will be in the standard
value, by moving the hood.
(3) Tighten the hood side hinge bolts after the adjustment.
Torque: 13 N⋅m (130 kgf⋅cm, 10 ft⋅lbf)
B51373
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3722
75-2
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
(b)
-
HOOD
Adjust the height of the hood front end using the cushion
rubber.
HINT:
Raise and lower the cushion rubber by turning it.
B51374
(c)
Adjust the hood lock.
(1) Using a screwdriver, disengage the clips and remove the hood lock release lever cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip
B51387
(2)
(3)
Loosen the 3 bolts.
Adjust the hood lock position so that the lock will
come in, by moving the lock.
(4) Tighten the hood lock bolts after the adjustment.
Torque: 7.0 N⋅m (71 kgf⋅cm, 62 in.⋅lbf)
B51375
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3723
75-1 1
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
REAR DOOR
750GU-04
ADJUSTMENT
HINT:
Before adjusting the door position for vehicles equipped with side airbags and curtain shield airbags,
be sure to disconnect the battery. After adjustment, inspect the SRS warning lamp, the side airbag
system and the curtain shield airbag system for normal operation. Then initialize both airbag systems.
Use the same procedure for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Centering Bolt
Centering bolts are used to mount the door hinge to the
vehicle body and door. The door cannot be adjusted with
the centering bolts on. Substitute the centering bolts with
standard bolts (w/ washers) when making adjustments.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
Standard Bolt
B79352
1.
(a)
INSPECT REAR DOOR PANEL SUB-ASSY LH
Check that the clearance is within the standard value.
Standard
B
C
A: 3.5 to 6.5 mm (0.138 to 0.256 in.)
B: 3.5 to 6.5 mm (0.130 to 0.256 in.)
C: 3.8 to 6.8 mm (0.128 to 0.268 in.)
D: 5.8 to 8.8 mm (0.228 to 0.346 in.)
E: 3.5 to 6.5 mm (0.138 to 0.256 in.)
D
A
E
B51626
2.
(a)
ADJUST REAR DOOR PANEL SUB-ASSY LH
Disconnected the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
CAUTION:
Work must be started 90 seconds after the ignition switch
is turned is the ”LOCK” position and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery. (The SRS is
equipped with a back-up power source so that if work is
started within 90 seconds from disconnecting the negative
(-) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS may be deployed.)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3732
75-12
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
Body Side
(b)
(c)
Door Side
(d)
(e)
Body Side
(a)
-
REAR DOOR
Adjust the door by loosening the body side hinge nuts.
Tighten the body side hinge nuts after the adjustment.
Torque: 26 N⋅m (272 kgf⋅cm, 18 ft⋅lbf)
Adjust the door by loosening the door side hinge bolts.
Tighten the door side hinge bolts after the adjustment.
Torque: 27 N⋅m (275 kgf⋅cm, 20 ft⋅lbf)
Door Side
(b)
B51541
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
Adjust the striker position by slightly loosening the striker
mounting screws and hitting the striker with a plastic hammer.
Tighten the striker mounting screws again.
Torque: 23 N⋅m (235 kgf⋅cm, 17 ft⋅lbf)
Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery.
Initialize both airbag systems.
Check the SRS warning lamp (see page 05-1207 ).
B51397
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3733
75-10
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
REAR DOOR
REAR DOOR
7508O-04
COMPONENTS
Rear Door Glass
Rear Door Quarter Rear Door
Rear Door Outside
Window Glass
Outside Handle Handle Cover
Rear Door Window
Division Bar
Rear Door Outside
Handle Rear Pad
Rear Door Outside
Rear Door Outside Handle Frame
Handle Pad
Rear Door
Inside Handle
Rear Door
Glass Run
Rear Door
Lock Assembly
5.0 (51, 44 in.·lbf)
Rear Door
Belt Moulding
5.5 (56, 49 in.⋅lbf)
23 (235, 17)
Rear Door Window
Regulator
27 (275, 20)
11 (112, 8)
26 (272, 18)
5.4 (54, 48 in.·lbf)
27 (275, 20)
Rear Door Inside
Handle Bezel
Door Pull Handle
Power Window
Regulator Motor
Rear Door Service
Hole Cover
Rear Trim Board
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, in.⋅lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B52499
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3731
75-13
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
REAR DOOR
7501X-05
OVERHAUL
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
(a)
Clip
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 clips and remove
the door pull handle.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B51528
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
Remove the screw.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 3 claws and remove
the door inside handle bezel.
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the screw.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 7 clips and remove
the trim board, and then disconnect the connector.
: Claw
B78829
B52219
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
: Clip
B51388
B78830
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE SUB-ASSY
LH
Remove the bolt.
Remove the inside handle, and then disconnect the 2
cables from the rear door lock.
Claw
B51531
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3734
75-14
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
5.
6.
(a)
(b)
7.
8.
-
REAR DOOR
REMOVE REAR DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
REMOVE REAR SPEAKER ASSY
Remove the 3 bolts.
Disconnect the connector and remove the rear speaker.
REMOVE REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSY LH (See page 76-12 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR GLASS RUN LH
9.
(a)
REMOVE REAR DOOR WINDOW DIVISION BAR
SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the 2 bolts, screw and division bar.
B51530
10.
REMOVE REAR DOOR QUARTER WINDOW GLASS LH
B51435
12.
(a)
13.
(a)
14.
(a)
11. REMOVE REAR DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSY LH
HINT:
Insert a shop rag inside the door panel to prevent scratching the
glass.
(a) Open the door glass.
(b) Tilt the door glass and disconnect the roller of the regulator from the glass channel to remove the door glass.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the door glass.
HINT:
Pull the glass upward to remove it.
REMOVE REAR DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the 4 bolts and window regulator.
REMOVE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY LH
Using a torx driver (T25), remove the 3 screws and motor.
APPLY BODY GREASE
Apply MP grease to the sliding and rotating parts of the regulator.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3735
75-15
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
15.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
-
REAR DOOR
REMOVE REAR DOOR LOCK ASSY LH
Disconnect the connectors.
Disconnect the links from the rear door outside handle.
Remove the bolt.
Using a torx socket wrench (T30), remove the 4 screws
and rear door lock.
B52377
16.
(a)
APPLY BODY GREASE
Apply MP grease to the sliding and rotating parts of the door lock.
17.
(a)
(b)
(c)
B51386
(d)
18.
(a)
A
B
B52377
19.
(a)
20.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE FRAME
SUB-ASSY LH
Using a torx socket wrench (T30), remove the 2 screws.
Using a screwdriver, pry out the rear outside handle cover.
Pushing the outside handle in the arrow mark direction as
shown in the illustration, remove the outside handle and
outside handle frame.
Using a torx socket wrench (T30), remove the screw
and frame.
Torque: 4.0 N⋅m (41 kgf⋅cm, 36 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR DOOR LOCK ASSY LH
Using a torx socket wrench (T30), install the rear door
lock with the 4 screws.
Torque:
5.0 N⋅m (50 kgf⋅cm, 44 in.⋅lbf) for A
5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf) for B
Install the bolts.
Connect the links to the rear outside handle.
Connect the connectors.
INSTALL POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSY LH
Using a torx driver (T25), install the regulator motor with the 3 screws.
Torque: 5.4 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 48 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR SUB-ASSY LH
Install the window regulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 11.0 N⋅m (112 kgf⋅cm, 8 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3736
75-16
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
B51537
-
REAR DOOR
21. INSTALL REAR DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Install a new service hole cover to the door panel.
HINT:
When installing the service hole cover, pull out the links
and connectors through the service hole cover.
There should be no wrinkles or folds after attaching the
service hole cover.
After attaching the service hole cover, check the sealing
condition.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3737
75-23
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
BACK DOOR STAY ASSY LH
75022-04
DISPOSAL
1.
(a)
(b)
a
A
b
B
B65104
DISPOSE OF BACK DOOR STAY ASSY LH
Horizontally fix the stay in a vise with the piston-rod pulled
out.
Wearing safety glasses, gradually cut a part between A
and B (shown in the illustration) using a metal saw to gradually release the gas.
Specification:
Area
Measurement
a
80 mm (3.15 in.)
b
20 mm (0.80 in.)
CAUTION:
Be careful to cover the area that is being cut as there is a
possibility that metal debris could be blown out by the gas
(the gas is colorless, odorless and harmless).
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3744
75-22
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
BACK DOOR STAY ASSY LH
BACK DOOR STAY ASSY LH
75021-04
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring addition information are included.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
(a)
REMOVE BACK DOOR STAY ASSY LH
Remove the 4 bolts and back door stay from the back door
panel.
HINT:
While supporting the back door by hand, remove the back door
stay.
B51401
2.
(a)
INSTALL BACK DOOR STAY ASSY LH
Install the back door stay with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3743
75-18
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
BACK DOOR
7501Z-04
ADJUSTMENT
HINT:
Centering Bolt
Standard Bolt
Centering bolts are used to mount the door hinge to the
vehicle body and door. The door cannot be adjusted with
the centering bolts on. Substitute the centering bolts with
standard bolts (w/ washers) when making adjustments.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
B77635
1.
(a)
INSPECT BACK DOOR PANEL SUB-ASSY
Check that the clearance is within the standard value.
A: 5.9 to 8.9 mm (0.232 to 0.350 in.)
B: 5.8 to 8.8 mm (0.228 to 0.346 in.)
C: 3.8 to 6.8 mm (0.150 to 0.268 in.)
D: 2.5 to 0.5 mm (0.039 to 0.059 in.)
Standard
A
C
D
B
B51542
B79656
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
B51377
ADJUST BACK DOOR PANEL SUB-ASSY
Adjust the door by loosening the door side hinge bolts.
Tighten the door side hinge bolts after the adjustment.
Torque:
8.0 N⋅m (82 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf) for door side
Adjust the door by loosening the body side hinge nuts.
Tighten the body side hinge nuts after the adjustment.
Torque:
19.5 N⋅m (199 kgf⋅cm, 14 ft⋅lbf) for body side
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3739
75-19
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
(e)
(f)
(g)
-
BACK DOOR
Check that the door fit and door linkage are adjusted correctly.
Adjust the striker by loosening the striker mounting
screws.
Torque: 23 N⋅m (235 kgf⋅cm, 17 ft⋅lbf)
Using a plastic hammer, tap the striker for adjustment.
B51437
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3740
75-17
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
BACK DOOR
BACK DOOR
7508P-04
COMPONENTS
Back Window Panel Upper Trim
8.0 (82, 71 in.·lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.·lbf)
Back Door Trim Cover
19.5 (199, 14)
5.5 (56, 49 in.·lbf)
Back Door Key Cylinder
19.5 (199, 14)
Back Door Cylindrer
to Lock Control Link
5.5 (56, 49 in.·lbf)
Back Door Trim Panel
Assist Strap
Back Door Lock
Assist Strap Cover
Back Door Outside Handle
12.5 (128, 9)
Back Door Outside Garnish
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, in.⋅lbf) : Specified torque
B52258
B78828
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3738
75-20
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
-
BACK DOOR
75020-04
OVERHAUL
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
(a)
Clip
REMOVE BACK WINDOW PANEL TRIM UPPER
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 clips and remove
the trim.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B51398
2.
(a)
Clip
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM COVER RH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 3 clips and remove
the trim.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B51399
3.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM COVER LH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the RH side.
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Clip
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM PANEL ASSY
Remove the assist strap cover.
Remove the bolt and assist strap.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 16 clips and remove
the back door trim panel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B51400
5.
w/ Rear spoiler:
REMOVE REAR SPOILER (See page 76-8 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3741
75-21
ENGINE HOOD/DOOR
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
7.
(a)
8.
(a)
9.
10.
(a)
11.
(a)
12.
-
BACK DOOR
REMOVE BACK DOOR LOCK ASSY
Disconnect the control cable from the outside handle.
Disconnect the back door cylinder to lock control link from the key cylinder.
Remove the 3 bolts and the lock control.
REMOVE BACK DOOR LOCK CYLINDER ASSY
Remove the 2 bolts and cylinder.
REMOVE BACK DOOR HANDLE ASSY OUTSIDE
Remove the 2 nuts and outside handle.
REMOVE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR GARNISH SUB-ASSY OUTSIDE (See page
76-13 )
INSTALL BACK DOOR HANDLE ASSY OUTSIDE
Install the outside handle with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf) for B
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOCK CYLINDER ASSY
Install the cylinder with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (56 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf) for B
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOCK ASSY
Torque: 12.5 N⋅m (128 kgf⋅cm, 9 ft⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3742
76-8
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
REAR SPOILER
REAR SPOILER
7602Y-03
REPLACEMENT
1.
REMOVE BACK WINDOW PANEL TRIM UPPER (See page 75-20 )
2.
(a)
(b)
Clip
Adhesive Tape
B51573
REMOVE REAR SPOILER
Remove the 2 bolts and nut.
Using a heat light, heat the body and rear spoiler to 40 to
60C (104 to 140F).
NOTICE:
Do not heat the rear spoiler excessively.
(c) Tie both piano wire ends to a wooden block or a similar
object.
(d) Scrape the adhesive tape off by pulling the piano wire.
NOTICE:
If reusing the rear spoiler, take care not to damage the
rear spoiler.
Do not damage the body.
(e) Remove the rear spoiler.
3.
INSTALL REAR SPOILER
(a) Using a heat light, heat the body and rear spoiler surface
to 40 to 60C (104 to 140F).
NOTICE:
Do not heat the body and rear spoiler excessively.
(b) Remove the adhesive tape from the body.
(c) Wipe off the stains with cleaner.
(d) If reusing the rear spoiler:
Clean the rear spoiler .
(1) Using a heat light, heat the body and rear spoiler to
20 to 30C (68 to 86F).
NOTICE:
Do not heat the body and rear spoiler excessively.
(2) Remove the adhesive tape from the rear spoiler.
(3) Wipe off the stains with cleaner.
(4)
(e)
Apply new adhesive tape to the rear spoiler as
shown in the illustration.
Using a heat light, heat the body and rear spoiler.
Heating temperature:
Body
40 to 60C (104 to 140F)
Moulding
20 to 30C (68 to 86F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the body and rear spoiler excessively.
Adhesive Tape
B51574
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3752
76-9
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
REAR SPOILER
(f)
Lift the rear spoiler and release the release sheet from the
surface of the rear spoiler.
NOTICE:
When the rear spoiler release sheet is removed, take
care that no dirt or no dust can get onto the uncoated
area.
Do not apply excessive force onto the rear spoiler but
steady pressure with your thumbs.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3753
76-1 1
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSY LH
FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSY LH
76026-07
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
REMOVE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSY (See page 75-6 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET GARNISH LH (See page 75-6 )
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page 75-6 )
REMOVE FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUB-ASSY LH (See page 75-6 )
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Protective
Tape
REMOVE FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSY LH
Remove the screw.
Put protective tape under the moulding.
Using a moulding remover or scraper, remove the moulding.
B51648
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3755
76-12
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSY LH
REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSY LH
7602A-06
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page 75-13 )
REMOVE REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUB-ASSY LH (See page 75-13 )
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Protective Tape
REMOVE REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSY LH
Remove the screw.
Put protective tape under the moulding.
Using a moulding remover or scraper, remove the moulding.
B51644
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3756
76-10
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
NAME PLATE
NAME PLATE
76025-07
REPLACEMENT
(LH)
(RH)
68.5 (2.701)
66 (2.60)
66 (2.60)
40.5 (1.594)
68.5 (2.697)
40.5 (1.594)
(3MZ-FE 4WD)
107.4 (4.228)
43.5 (1.713)
33.9(1.335)
28.8 (1.134)
118.1 (4.650)
74.4 (2.960)
75.2 (2.960)
269 (10.59)
(4WD)
71.5 (2.815)
74.4(2.929)
67(2.64)
(3MZ-FE)
251.8 (9.913)
88 (3.46)
268.3 (10.563)
74.3 (2.925)
mm (in.)
B51620
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3754
76-16
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING CENTER LH
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING CENTER LH
7602B-07
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
The installation is in the reverse order of the removal. However, when there is a special point concerning the installation, it is indicated.
On the RH side, use the same procedures as on the LH side.
1.
REMOVE ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
CENTER LH
(a) Cover the circumference of the moulding with protective
tape for protection.
(b) Using a remover for the roof moulding, release the engagements of the clips in both front and rear ends of the
moulding, and then remove the moulding.
NOTICE:
Do not remove the clips.
B51649
In case that the clips are damaged or removed accidentally, exchange them for supplied ones.
2.
INSTALL ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING CLIP NO.2
NOTICE:
Only when exchanging the clips.
(a) Remove the adhesive tape that remains on the mounting surface of the body, and then clean the surface with white gasoline.
(b) Using a heat light, heat up the clip installation surfaces of the body and moulding.
Heating temperature:
Protective Tape
Body
40 to 60C (104 to 140F)
Moulding
20 to 30C (68 to 86F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the body and moulding excessively.
(c) Set the supplied clips into the positions as shown in the illustration, and press-fit those clips by hand
to install them.
(d) Install the moulding when 30 minutes or more have passed after press-fitting the clips.
HINT:
Initial hardening time: 30 minutes
Prefect hardening time: 24 hours
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3760
76-17
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING CENTER LH
Rear Side
Front Side
2093 (82.4)
1836 (72.28)
1496 (58.9)
1185 (46.65)
874 (34.41)
558 (21.97)
293 (11.54)
63 (2.48)
Roof Drip Side Finish Moulding Clip No.2
mm (in.)
B51650
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3761
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR GARNISH
SUB-ASSY OUTSIDE
76-13
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR GARNISH SUB-ASSY
OUTSIDE
76027-07
REPLACEMENT
1.
REMOVE BACK WINDOW PANEL TRIM UPPER (See page 75-20 )
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM COVER RH (See page 75-20 )
3.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM COVER LH (See page 75-20 )
4.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM PANEL ASSY (See page 75-20 )
5.
REMOVE REAR SPOILER (W/ REAR SPOILER) (See page 75-20 )
6.
REMOVE BACK DOOR LOCK ASSY (See page 75-20 )
7.
REMOVE BACK DOOR HANDLE ASSY OUTSIDE (See page 75-20 )
8.
REMOVE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR GARNISH SUB-ASSY OUTSIDE
(a) Remove the screws and the 2 licence plate lights.
(b) Remove the nut and garnish.
9.
INSTALL LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR NAME PLATE NO.1
(a) Using white gasoline, clean the garnish installation surface.
(b) Using a heat light, heat the garnish and name plate to 20 to 30C (68 to 86F).
(c) Install the name plate.
NOTICE:
Do not heat the garnish and name plate excessively.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3757
76-14
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
OUTSIDE MOULDING
OUTSIDE MOULDING
7615W-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
1.
(a)
Protective
Tape
B51665
REMOVE OUTSIDE MOULDING
Using a heat light, heat the body and moulding to 40 to
60C (104 to 140F).
NOTICE:
Do not heat the body and moulding excessively.
(b) Tie both piano wire ends to a wooden block or a similar
object.
(c) Scrape the adhesive tape off by pulling the piano wire as
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
If reusing the moulding, take care not to damage the
moulding.
Do not damage the body.
2.
INSTALL OUTSIDE MOULDING
(a) Using a heat light, heat the body mounting surface to 40 to 60C (104 to 140F).
NOTICE:
Do not heat the body excessively.
(b) Remove the protective tape from the body.
(c) Wipe off the stains with cleaner.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3758
76-15
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
OUTSIDE MOULDING
(d)
Clean the moulding (if reusing the moulding).
(1) Using a heat light, heat the body and moulding to 20 to 30C (68 to 86F).
NOTICE:
Do not heat the body and moulding excessively.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the moulding.
(3) Wipe off the stains with cleaner.
(4) Apply new double-sided tape to the moulding as shown in the illustration.
Double-sided Tape
Boss
B51667
(e)
Using a heat light, heat the body and moulding.
Heating temperature:
Body
40 to 60C (104 to 140F)
Moulding
20 to 30C (68 to 86F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the body and moulding excessively.
(f)
Remove the peeling paper from the moulding face.
NOTICE:
When the peeling paper is removed, take care that dirt or
dust do not stick to the adhesive area.
(g) Attach the moulding securely to the body, as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not apply excessive force onto the moulding, but steady
pressure with your thumbs.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3759
76-1
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
FRONT BUMPER
FRONT BUMPER
7616V-02
COMPONENTS
Front Fender Splash
Shield Sub-assy RH
77 (780, 57)
Front Bumper
Reinforcement
Front Fender Splash
Shield Sub-assy LH
Front Bumper
Energy Absorber
Radiator Grille
Front Bumper Cover
w/o Fog Lamp:
Front Bumper Hole Cover RH
5.5 (55, 49 in.⋅lbf)
w/o Fog Lamp:
Front Bumper
Hole Cover LH
w/ Fog Lamp
w/ Fog Lamp
Fog Lamp Assy RH
Fog Lamp Assy LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
: Specified torque
B74709
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3745
76-2
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
FRONT BUMPER
7616W-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
1.
(a)
Clip A
Clip B
Clip B
Clip
Claw
REMOVE RADIATOR GRILLE
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws and remove
the 4 clips labeled A, 2 clips labeled B and grille.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Claw
B74702
2.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD
SUB-ASSY LH
Remove the screw and 3 clips.
Partially remove the fender liner.
(a)
(b)
HINT:
It is not necessary to fully remove the fender liner completely.
Partially remove it so that the bumper cover can be removed in
step (4).
B74703
3.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER SPLASH SHIELD SUB-ASSY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3746
76-3
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
Claw
Claw
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
-
FRONT BUMPER
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER
Put protective tape under the front fender.
Remove the 6 screws.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the bumper cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(d) w/ Fog lamp:
Disconnect the 2 connectors.
Protective Tape
B74704
5.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
6.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT
Remove the 6 bolts and reinforcement.
B74705
7.
8.
9.
REMOVE FOG LAMP ASSY LH (W/ FOG LAMP)
REMOVE FOG LAMP ASSY RH (W/ FOG LAMP)
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER HOLE COVER (W/O FOG LAMP)
10.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT
Install the reinforcement with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 77 N⋅m (780 kgf⋅cm, 57 ft⋅lbf)
B74705
11.
(a)
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER COVER
Install the bumper cover with the 6 screws.
Torque: 5.5 N⋅m (55 kgf⋅cm, 49 in.⋅lbf)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3747
76-4
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
REAR BUMPER
REAR BUMPER
7616X-01
COMPONENTS
Rear Bumper
Side Retainer RH
3.0 (31, 27 in.⋅lbf)
Rear Floor
Finish Plate
Rear Bumper
Side Retainer LH
3.0 (31, 27 in.⋅lbf)
Rear Bumper
Support No. 1
Rear Bumper Side
Mounting Bracket RH
Rear Bumper
Reinforcement No. 1
Rear Bumper
Support No. 1
27 (275, 20)
Rear Bumper Side
Mounting Bracket LH
w/ Quarter Panel Mudguard
Sub-assy RH
Rear Bumper Bar
Rear Bumper Bar RH Rear Bumper
Side Support RH
Rear Bumper
Rear Bumper
Bar LH
Energy Absorber
8.0 (85, 71 in.⋅lbf)
Rear Bumper
Side Support LH
3.0 (31, 27 in.⋅lbf)
w/ Quarter Panel Mudguard
Sub-assy LH
3.0 (31, 27 in.⋅lbf)
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
Rear Bumper Cover
: Specified torque
B74710
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3748
76-5
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
REAR BUMPER
7616Y-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
2.
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX FRONT
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX REAR
Clip C
3.
(a)
Clip A
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip B
Clip A
REMOVE REAR FLOOR FINISH PLATE
Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 clips labeled A and 2
clips labeled B, 4 clips labeled C and finish plate.
Clip B
Clip C
B74706
4.
(a)
REMOVE QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUB-ASSY
REAR LH (W/ MUDGUARD)
Remove the 3 clips, screw and mudguard.
B52221
5.
REMOVE QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUB-ASSY REAR RH (W/ MUDGUARD)
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
6.
(a)
REMOVE REAR BUMPER COVER
Put protective tape under the quarter panel.
Protective
Tape
B78873
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3749
76-6
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
(b)
(c)
-
REAR BUMPER
Remove the 6 screws, 4 nuts and 2 clips.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the claw labeled A, 4
claws labeled B and bumper cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Claw B
Claw A
B74707
7.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
8.
(a)
REMOVE REAR BUMPER REINFORCEMENT NO.1
Remove the 6 nuts and reinforcement.
B74708
9.
10.
11.
12.
(a)
13.
(a)
14.
15.
(a)
16.
(a)
17.
18.
19.
(a)
REMOVE REAR BUMPER BAR
REMOVE REAR BUMPER BAR LH
REMOVE REAR BUMPER BAR RH
REMOVE REAR BUMPER SIDE RETAINER LH
Remove the 3 screws and side retainer.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER SIDE RETAINER RH
Remove the 3 screws and side retainer.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER SUPPORT NO.1
REMOVE REAR BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING BRACKET LH
Remove the screw and bracket.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
Remove the screw and bracket.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT LH
REMOVE REAR BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT RH
INSTALL REAR BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING BRACKET LH
Install the bracket with the screw.
Torque: 3.0 N⋅m (31 kgf⋅cm, 27 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR BUMPER SIDE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
20.
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3750
76-7
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
21.
(a)
22.
(a)
(b)
23.
(a)
-
REAR BUMPER
INSTALL REAR BUMPER REINFORCEMENT NO.1
Install the reinforcement with the 6 nuts.
Torque: 27 N⋅m (275 kgf⋅cm, 20 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL REAR BUMPER COVER
Engage the 10 claws.
Install the bumper cover with the 2 clips, 6 screws and 4 nuts.
Torque: 3.0 N⋅m (31 kgf⋅cm, 27 in.⋅lbf) for bolt
Torque: 8.0 N⋅m (85 kgf⋅cm, 71 in.⋅lbf) for nut
INSTALL QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUB-ASSY REAR LH (W/ MUDGUARD)
Install the mudguard with the 3 clips and bolt.
Torque: 3.0 N⋅m (31 kgf⋅cm, 27 in.⋅lbf)
INSTALL QUARTER PANEL MUDGUARD SUB-ASSY REAR RH (W/ MUDGUARD)
24.
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3751
76-18
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
7616Z-01
COMPONENTS
w/ Sliding Roof
Roof Silencer Pad No. 1
Sun Roof Opening
Trim Moulding
Roof Silencer Pad No. 4
Roof Silencer Pad No. 5
Roof Headlining Assy
Roof Silencer Pad No. 4
Roof Silencer Pad No. 5
Roof Silencer Pad No. 1
w/o Sliding Roof only:
Roof Silencer Pad No. 2
Assist Grip
Sub-assembly
Room Lamp
Assy No.2
Roof Headlining Assy
RH Visor Assy
Assist Grip
Sub-assy
Room Lamp
Assy No. 1
Visor Holder
Roof Console
Box Assy
Visor Holder
LH Visor Assy
B77744
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3762
76-19
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
Rear Floor
Finish Plate
Tonneau Cover Assy
Back Door
Weatherstrip
Deck Board
Sub-assy No. 2
Rear Door Opening
Trim Weatherstrip RH
Quarter Pillar
Garnish RH
Front Door Opening
Trim Weatherstrip RH
Roof Side Rail
Garnish Assy RH
Deck Board
Sub-assy No. 3
Deck Board
Sub-assy
Center Pillar
Garnish RH
Front Pillar
Garnish RH
Roof Side Garnish
Assy Inner RH
Deck Side
Trim Box RH
Deck Floor
Box Rear
Deck Trim Side
Panel Assy RH
Rear No. 1 Seat
Outer Belt Assy RH
42 (420, 31)
Front Door
Scuff Plate RH
Rear Door
Scuff Plate RH
Center Pillar
Garnish Lower RH
Front Seat Outer
Belt Assy RH
Deck Side
Trim Box LH
Roof Side Rail
Garnish Assy LH
Roof Side Garnish
Assy Inner LH
Rear No. 1 Seat
Outer Belt Assy LH
42 (420, 31)
Front Pillar
Garnish LH
Quarter Pillar
Garnish LH
Deck Floor
Box Front
Center Pillar
Garnish LH
Front Seat Outer
Belt Assy LH
Deck Trim Side
Panel Assy LH
Front Door Opening
Trim Weatherstrip LH
Rear Door
Scuff Plate LH
Front Door Scuff Plate LH
Center Pillar
Garnish Lower LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
Rear Door Opening
Trim Weatherstrip LH
: Specified torque
B77611
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3763
76-20
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
w/ Rear No. 2 Seat
Rear Floor Finish Plate
Deck Board
Sub-assy No.2
Roof Side Rail
Garnish Sub-assy RH
Roof Side Garnish
Assy Inner RH
Rear No. 2 Seat
Outer Belt Assy RH
Deck Board
Sub-assy
Deck Side
Trim Box RH
Quarter Pillar
Garnish RH
Deck Board
Sub-assy No.3
Deck Floor
Box Rear
42 (420, 31)
Roof Side Rail Garnish
Sub-assy LH
Rear No. 2 Seat
Outer Belt Assy LH
Deck Side
Trim Box LH
Deck Trim Side
Panel Assy RH
Roof Side Garnish
Assy Inner LH
Quarter Pillar Garnish LH
Rear Door
Scuff Plate RH
Rear Door
Scuff Plate LH
N⋅m (kgf⋅cm, ft⋅lbf)
Deck Trim Side
Panel Assy LH
: Specified torque
B77612
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3764
76-21
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
76170-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
1.
The installation procedures are the removal procedures in reverse order. However, only installation
procedures requiring additional information are included.
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard bolt chart (see page 03-2 ).
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER ASSY
2.
(a)
w/o Rear No. 2 Seat
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 5 clips, 2 bolts and
deck board.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
w/ Rear No. 2 Seat
Clip
B51632
B77333
3.
4.
B78481
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY NO.2
REMOVE DECK BOARD SUB-ASSY NO.3
5.
Clip
Clip
(a)
REMOVE REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER NO.2 RH
(w/ REAR NO. 2 SEAT)
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 clips and remove
the bolt and cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B78269
6.
REMOVE REAR SEAT RECLINING COVER NO.2 LH (w/ REAR NO. 2 SEAT)
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3765
76-22
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
7.
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX REAR
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 clips and box rear.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip
Clip
B77336
8.
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX FRONT (w/o REAR NO. 2 SEAT)
Clip A
9.
(a)
Clip B
Clip A
REMOVE REAR FLOOR FINISH PLATE
Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 clips labeled A, 4 clips
labeled B and finish plate.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B77334
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM BOX LH
REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM BOX RH
REMOVE REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY LH (See page 72-28 , 72-44 )
REMOVE REAR NO.1 SEAT ASSY RH (See page 72-35 , 72-54 )
REMOVE REAR NO.2 SEAT ASSEMBLY (w/ REAR NO. 2 SEAT) (See page 72-61 )
15.
(a)
Claw C
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 4 claws labeled A, 2
claws labeled B, claw labeled C and remove the scuff
plate.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Claw B
Claw A
Claw A
Claw A
B78482
16. REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3766
76-23
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
17.
(a)
Claw
Claw
-
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the scuff plate.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B51628
18. REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
19. REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP LH
20. REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH
21. REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP LH
22. REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH
23. REMOVE BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
24.
(a)
Claw
Clip
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the 5 clips and garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B78282
25. REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
Claw B
26.
(a)
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws labeled A and
2 claws labeled B, Remove the cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the shoulder anchor bolt.
Claw A
B77325
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3767
76-24
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
(c)
(d)
-
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
Remove the 2 screws.
Using a screwdriver, disengage the clip and remove the
garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip
B77326
27. REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
28. REMOVE ROPE HOOK
29. REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM COVER LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the cover and screw.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the trim box.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Claw
B75576
30. REMOVE DECK SIDE TRIM COVER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
31.
(a)
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSY LH
w/o Rear No. 2 seat:
(1) Remove the 5 bolts and rear seat outer belt floor anchor bolt.
(2) Using a clip remover, remove the 6 clips and side
panel.
(b)
w/ Rear No. 2 seat:
(1) Remove the 5 bolts and rear seat outer belt floor anchor bolt.
(2) Using a clip remover, remove the 6 clips and side
panel.
Clip
B78270
Clip
B78271
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3768
76-25
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
32. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
33.
(a)
Clip B
REMOVE QUARTER PILLAR GARNISH LH
Using a screwdriver, remove the clip labeled A and clip labeled B and garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip A
B51636
34. REMOVE QUARTER PILLAR GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
35.
(a)
Claw
Claw
REMOVE ROOF SIDE RAIL GARNISH SUB-ASSY LH
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 3 clips and remove
the 3 claws and rail garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip
Clip
B51637
36. REMOVE ROOF SIDE RAIL GARNISH SUB-ASSY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
37.
(a)
REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSY INNER LH
w/o Rear No. 2 seat:
(1) Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 clips and side
garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B78283
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3769
76-26
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
Clip A
(b)
-
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
w/ Rear No. 2 seat:
(1) Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 clips labeled A,
clip labeled B, remove the side garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip B
B75577
38. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH ASSY INNER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
39. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the front pillar garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Pull the garnish upward and remove it from the instrument
panel.
Clip
B51639
(c)
Pillar
Garnish
Clip A
Clip A
90
Clip B
w/ Curtain shield airbag:
(1) Using a screwdriver, disengage the clips clip labeled A and clip labeled B.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(d) Remove the pillar garnish.
(1) Pull the pillar garnish until the clip marked A in the
illustration stretches.
(2) Turn the clip marked A in the illustration 90 degrees
and remove the pillar garnish.
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
B78340
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3770
76-27
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
(e)
120 mm
(4.72 in.)
700 mm (27.56 in.)
Protect the curtain shield airbag LH.
(1) Cover the airbag with cloth or a piece of nylon
approximately 700 mm (27.56 in.) x 120 mm (4.72
in.) in size. Fix the ends of the cover with tape as
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Cover the curtain shield airbag with the protective cover as
soon as the front pillar garnish is removed.
Adhesive
Tape
Protective Cover
B78285
40. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
41. REMOVE LH VISOR ASSY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and visor.
42. REMOVE RH VISOR ASSY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and visor.
43. REMOVE ROOF CONSOLE BOX ASSY
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 clips.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B77329
44.
(a)
REMOVE ROOM LAMP ASSY NO.1
Using a screwdriver, disengage the 2 claws and remove
the 2 clips and lamp.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
45. REMOVE ROOM LAMP ASSY NO.2
B77331
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3771
76-28
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
46. REMOVE ASSIST GRIP SUB-ASSY
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the assist grip plug.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and assist grip.
Protective
Tape
B80187
47.
(a)
REMOVE VISOR HOLDER
Remove the holder of the sun visor by turning it to the left.
B50596
48.
REMOVE SUN ROOF OPENING TRIM MOULDING
49.
(a)
w/o Sliding Roof
(b)
w/ Sliding Roof
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
Using a clip remover, remove the 4 clips and roof headlining.
Remove the headlining from the back door.
Clip
B51643
50.
51.
52.
53.
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
ROOF
ROOF
ROOF
ROOF
SILENCER
SILENCER
SILENCER
SILENCER
PAD NO.4
PAD NO.1
PAD NO.5
PAD NO.2 (W/O SLIDING ROOF)
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3772
76-29
EXTERIOR/INTERIOR TRIM
-
ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
54.
(a)
INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSY
Align the markings, and then install the wire harness with
tape.
NOTICE:
Attach the roof wire harness securely.
(b) Install the roof headlining with the 4 clips.
w/o Sliding Roof
w/ Sliding Roof
B77330
55.
(a)
INSTALL QUARTER PILLAR GARNISH LH
Install the rear No. 2 seat outer belt shoulder anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42.0 N⋅m (420 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
INSTALL QUARTER PILLAR GARNISH RH
56.
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
57. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSY LH
(a) Install the rear seat outer belt floor anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42.0 N⋅m (420 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
58. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
59. INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LH
(a) Install the front seat outer belt shoulder anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42.0 N⋅m (420 kgf⋅cm, 31 ft⋅lbf)
60. INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3773
78-4
GARAGE DOOR OPENER
-
GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
78002-02
INSPECTION
These
Switches
1.
(a)
INSPECT GARAGE DOOR OPENER
Press the switch and check that each red LED turns on.
If one or more of the switches does not turn on the LED,
confirm normal operation of the fuse and wire harness,
then replace the garage door opener.
2.
INSPECT GARAGE DOOR OPENER REGISTRATION
AND TRANSMITTING
LED
B78298
Press
Original
Transmitter
B78299
HINT:
Use the KENTMORE home link tester and a tester transmitter
for this test. First erase the customer’s transmitter code, and the
register the tester transmitter code.
(a) Check if the tester transmitter code was successfully registered.
HINT:
If the code cannot be registered, replace the garage door opener.
(b)
Press
Home Link Tester
Press the garage door opener switch that was registered
to the tester transmitter. Check if the home link tester’s
green LED illuminates.
HINT:
If the green LED does not illuminate, replace the garage door
opener.
(c) When the inspection is complete, re-register the customer’s transmitter code(s) again.
B78304
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3777
78-1
GARAGE DOOR OPENER
-
GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
78003-02
REGISTRATION
1.
REGISTER TRANSMITTER CODE
HINT:
The vehicle’s garage door opener records transmitter codes for systems such as garage doors, gates, entry
gates, door locks, home lighting systems, security systems or other transmitter-code based systems. The
garage door opener is built into the dome lamp No. 1. If replacing the dome lamp No. 1, transmitter codes
for any systems previously registered in the garage door opener must be re-registered.
(a) Re-register systems in the garage door opener registration mode.
NOTICE:
Do not perform transmitter code registration for a system if people or objects are near the system. When registering transmitter codes for a system, injury or damage can occur because the
system may open, close, unlock or otherwise operate.
Before transmitter code registration, stop the engine and remove the key from the ignition
switch.
The garage door opener cannot be used with systems that: 1) were manufactured before April
1, 1982; or 2) systems that do not meet Federal Safety Standards (for example, garage doors
without a jam protection function).
HINT:
3 transmitter codes can be registered with the garage door opener, one transmitter code for each of
the 3 garage door opener switches.
Disconnecting the battery will not erase the transmitter codes registered with the garage door opener.
An attempt to overwrite a previously registered transmitter code with a new system’s transmitter code
may fail. In these situations, the previously registered transmitter code will not be erased.
These
Switches
(1)
(2)
LED
B78298
Select a garage door opener switch for transmitter
code registration.
Press and hold the selected switch for 20 seconds.
The garage door opener will enter registration
mode.
HINT:
Before entering registration mode, the LED is ON. After entering registration mode, the LED flashes at a cycle of 1 Hz. For
a ”rolling code” type system, after entering registration mode,
the LED flashes at a cycle of 8.8 Hz for 1.6 seconds, and then
the LED flashes at a cycle of 1 Hz.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3774
78-2
GARAGE DOOR OPENER
(3)
Press
(4)
Original
Transmitter
B78299
-
GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
After the garage door opener has entered registration mode, bring the original transmitter of the system to be registered within 1 to 3 inches of the garage door opener and press and hold one of the
garage door opener switches. Then press the original transmitter switch.
If the transmitter code registration was successful,
the LED of the garage door opener flashes at a
cycle of 5.6 Hz. If no malfunction occurs, release
both the garage door opener switch and the original
transmitter switch.
HINT:
If transmitter code registration fails: 1) the original transmitter’s battery may be low or need to be replaced, or 2) the system to be registered may not be compatible with the garage door opener.
Some transmitter’s signals stop after 1 to 2 seconds. For these types of transmitters: 1) press and hold
one of the garage door opener switches, and 2) press and release (cycle) the transmitter switch every
2 seconds. Check if the transmitter code was successfully registered.
After entering the garage door opener registration mode, transmitter code registration must be completed within 90 seconds. If 90 seconds elapses, the garage door opener will enter low power mode
(see step (c)).
Timing Chart of Registration Mode:
PRESSED
Garage Door
Opener Switch
RELEASED
Registrat ion ENTER
Mode
EXIT
LED
Operation
Original
Transmitter
20 sec.
ON
OFF
LED flashes
at a cycle of 1 Hz
ON
LED flashes
at a cycle of 5.6 Hz
OFF
I03487
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3775
78-3
GARAGE DOOR OPENER
These
Switches
(b)
-
GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
Erase transmitter codes in the garage door opener clear
mode.
HINT:
LED
B78298
All 3 registered transmitter codes will be erased. No option exists for only erasing one transmitter code.
If the switches are released within 10 seconds after the
transmitter codes have been erased, the garage door
opener will enter registration mode.
If the switches are held for 10 seconds or more after the
transmitter codes have been erased, default codes will be
set to the 3 switches of the garage door opener. Using
these default codes, operation of the garage door opener
can be checked using a tester.
(1) Press and hold the left and right switch of the garage door opener for 20 seconds. The LED will begin to flash at a cycle of 5.6 Hz. Releasing the
switches will end clear mode.
Timing Chart of Clear Mode:
Garage Door
Opener Switches
(at both ends)
PRESSED
RELEASED
Enter clear mode to erase
all 3 codes
Load Default Code
ON
20 sec.
Clear Mode/Default Mode
10 sec.
OFF
ON
LED Operation
OFF
LED flashes at a cycle of 5.6 Hz
A53171
(c)
Low power mode:
(1) If a garage door opener switch is held for 75 seconds or more, the garage door opener will enter
low power mode to economize on power consumption. When the garage door opener has entered low power mode, the LED turns off.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3776
80-2
VEHICLE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
IGNITION SWITCH
8000H-05
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
B51200
INSPECT IGNITION OR STARTER SWITCH ASSY
Inspect the ignition switch continuity.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
LOCK
-
No continuity
ACC
1-3
Continuity
ON
1-2-3
5-6
Continuity
START
1-2
4-5-6
Continuity
If the continuity is not as specified, replace the ignition switch.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3779
80-1
VEHICLE CONTROL SYSTEM
-
IGNITION SWITCH
IGNITION SWITCH
8000G-04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Ignition switch is not set in each position
Suspected Area
See Page
1. Ignition switch
2. Power source circuit
80 2
80-2
-
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3778
82-1
CRUISE CONTROL
-
CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
8204Q-01
REPLACEMENT
HINT:
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1.
PRECAUTION (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
2.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL (SEE PAGE 60-1 )
3.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.2
4.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER NO.3
5.
REMOVE HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
Disconnect the connectors.
Remove the 2 screws and cruise control main switch.
B78426
7.
8.
9.
10.
INSTALL HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-17 )
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
INSPECT HORN BUTTON ASSY (SEE PAGE 60-1 1)
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (SEE PAGE 05-1207 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3780
99-1
MAINTENANCE
-
OUTSIDE VEHICLE
OUTSIDE VEHICLE
9900V-22
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
HINT:
These are maintenance and inspection items which are considered to be the owner’s responsibility.
They can be done by the owner or they can have them done at a service shop.
These items include those which should be checked on a daily basis, those which, in most cases, do not
require special tools and those which are considered to be reasonable for the owner to do.
Items and procedures for general maintenance are as follows.
1.
GENERAL NOTES
Maintenance items may vary from country to country. Check the owner’s manual supplement in which
the maintenance schedule is shown.
Every service item in the periodic maintenance schedule must be performed.
Periodic maintenance service must be performed according to whichever interval in the periodic maintenance schedule occurs first, the odometer reading (miles) or the time interval (months).
Maintenance service after the last period should be performed at the same interval as before unless
noted.
Failure to do even one of the items can cause the engine to run poorly and increase the exhaust emissions.
2.
TIRES
(a) Check the pressure with a gauge. If necessary, make adjustment.
(b) Check for cuts, damage or excessive wear.
3.
WHEEL NUTS
(a) When checking the tires, check the nuts for looseness or for missing nuts. If necessary, tighten them.
4.
TIRE ROTATION
(a) Check the owner’s manual supplement in which the maintenance schedule is shown.
5.
WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES
(a) Check for wear or cracks whenever they do not wipe clean. If necessary, replace them.
6.
FLUID LEAKS
(a) Check the underneath of the vehicle for leaks of fuel, oil, water or other fluid.
(b) If you smell gasoline fumes or notice any leak, find and correct the cause.
7.
DOORS AND ENGINE HOOD
(a) Check that all the doors and the tailgate operate smoothly, and that all the latches lock securely.
(b) Check that the engine hood secondary latch prevents the hood from opening when the primary latch
is released.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3781
99-2
MAINTENANCE
-
INSIDE VEHICLE
INSIDE VEHICLE
9900W-23
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
HINT:
These are maintenance and inspection items which are considered to be the owner’s responsibility.
They can be done by the owner or they can have them done at a service shop.
These items include those which should be checked on a daily basis, those which, in most cases, do not
require special tools and those which are considered to be reasonable for the owner to do.
Items and procedures for general maintenance are as follows.
1.
GENERAL NOTES
Maintenance items may vary from country to country. Check the owner’s manual supplement in which
the maintenance schedule is shown.
Every service item in the periodic maintenance schedule must be performed.
Periodic maintenance service must be performed according to whichever interval in the periodic maintenance schedule occurs first, the odometer reading (miles) or the time interval (months).
Maintenance service after the last period should be performed at the same interval as before unless
noted.
Failure to do even one of the items can cause the engine to run poorly and increase the exhaust emissions.
2.
LIGHTS
(a) Check that the headlights, stop lights, taillights, turn signal lights, and other lights are all working.
(b) Check the headlight aiming.
3.
WARNING LIGHTS AND BUZZERS
(a) Check that all the warning lights and buzzers function properly.
4.
HORN
(a) Check that the horn works normally.
5.
WINDSHIELD GLASS
(a) Check for scratches, pits or abrasions.
6.
WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER
(a) Check operation of the wipers and washer.
(b) Check that the wipers do not streak.
7.
WINDSHIELD DEFROSTER
(a) Check that air comes out from the defroster outlet when operating the heater or air conditioner in the
defroster mode.
8.
REAR VIEW MIRROR
(a) Check that the rear view mirror is mounted securely.
9.
SUN VISORS
(a) Check that the sun visors move freely and are mounted securely.
10. STEERING WHEEL
(a) Check that the steering wheel has the specified free play. Be alert for changes in steering condition,
such as hard steering, excessive free play or strange noises.
11. SEATS
(a) Check that all the front seat controls such as seat adjusters, seatback recliner, etc. operate smoothly.
(b) Check that all the latches lock securely in any position.
(c) Check that the locks hold securely in any latched position.
(d) Check that the head restraints move up and down smoothly and that the locks hold securely in any
latched position.
(e) For folding-down of the rear seatbacks, check that the latches lock securely.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3782
99-3
MAINTENANCE
12.
(a)
(b)
13.
(a)
14.
(a)
(b)
(c)
15.
(a)
16.
(a)
(b)
17.
(a)
-
INSIDE VEHICLE
SEAT BELTS
Check that the seat belt system such as the buckles, retractors and anchors operate properly and
smoothly.
Check that the belt webbing is not cut, frayed, worn or dameged.
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Check the pedal for smooth operation, uneven pedal effort or catching.
BRAKE PEDAL (See page 32-8 )
Check the pedal for smooth operation.
Check that the pedal has the proper reserve distance and freeplay.
Check the brake booster function.
BRAKES
At a safe place, check that the brakes do not pull to one side when applied.
PARKING BRAKE (See page 33-2 )
Check that the lever has the proper travel.
On a safe incline, check that the vehicle is held securely with only the parking brake applied.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ”PARK” MECHANISM
On a safe incline, check that the vehicle is held securely with the selector lever in the ”P” position and
all the brakes released.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3783
99-4
MAINTENANCE
-
UNDER HOOD
UNDER HOOD
9900X-21
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
1.
2.
(a)
3.
(a)
4.
(a)
(b)
5.
(a)
(b)
6.
(a)
7.
(a)
8.
(a)
9.
(a)
(b)
10.
(a)
(b)
(c)
GENERAL NOTES
Maintenance items may vary from country to country. Check the owner’s manual supplement in which
the maintenance schedule is shown.
Every service item in the periodic maintenance schedule must be performed.
Periodic maintenance service must be performed according to whichever interval in the periodic maintenance schedule occurs first, the odometer reading (miles) or the time interval (months).
Maintenance service after the last period should be performed at the same interval as before unless
noted.
Failure to do even one of the items can cause the engine to run poorly and/or increase the exhaust
emissions.
WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID
Check that there is sufficient fluid in the tank.
ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
Check that the coolant level is between the LEVEL lines on the see-through reservoir at normal temperature (20°C (68°F)).
RADIATOR AND HOSES
Check that the front of the radiator is clean and not blocked by leaves, dirt or bugs.
Check the hoses for cracks, kinks, rot or loose connections.
BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
Check the indicator.
Check that the electrolyte level of all the battery cells is between the upper and lower level lines on
the case.
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
Check that the brake fluid levels are near the upper level line on the see-through reservoirs.
ENGINE DRIVE BELT
Check the drive belt for fraying, cracks, wear or oiliness.
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
Check the level on the dipstick with the engine turned off.
POWER STEERING FLUID LEVEL
Check the level on the dipstick.
The level should be in the ”HOT” or ”COLD” range depending on the fluid temperature.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID LEVEL
Park the vehicle on a level surface.
With the engine idling and the parking brake applied, shift the selector into all the positions from ”P”
to ”L”, and then shift into the ”P” position.
Pull out the dipstick and wipe off the fluid with a clean shop rag. Re-insert the dipstick and check that
the fluid level is in the ”HOT” range.
Perform this check with the fluid at the normal driving temperature (70 to 80°C, 158 to 176°F).
(d)
HINT:
Wait until the engine cools down (approx. 30 min.) before checking the fluid level after extended driving at
high speed, in hot weather, in heavy traffic or after pulling a trailer.
11. EXHAUST SYSTEM
(a) Visually inspect for cracks, holes or loose supports.
If any change in the sound of the exhaust or the smell of the exhaust fumes is noticed, locate and correct
the cause.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3784
99-5
MAINTENANCE
-
ENGINE
ENGINE
9900Y-20
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
HINT:
Inspect these items when the engine is cold.
1.
REPLACE TIMING BELT (See page 2AZ-FE: 14-68 , 3MZ-FE: 14-206 )
2.
INSPECT DRIVE BELT (See page 2AZ-FE: 14-5 , 3MZ-FE: 14-125 )
3.
REPLACE SPARK PLUGS (See page 2AZ-FE: 18-1 , 3MZ-FE: 18-7 )
4.
Outside
(a)
(b)
Inside
A66289
5.
(a)
6.
7.
(a)
8.
9.
(a)
10.
(a)
11.
Canada:
INSPECT AIR FILTER
Remove the air filter.
Visually check that the air filter is not excessively damaged or oily.
HINT:
Oiliness may indicate that the PCV valve is stuck.
If necessary, replace the air filter.
(c) Clean the filter with compressed air.
First blow from the inside thoroughly, and then blow from
the outside of the filter.
(d) Reinstall the air filter.
REPLACE AIR FILTER
Replace the air filter with a new one.
REPLACE ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER (See page 2AZ-FE: 17-3 , 3MZ-FE: 17-21 )
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT (See page 2AZ-FE: 16-6 , 3MZ-FE: 16-26 ) AND INSPECT RADIATOR FIN
Check that the radiator and condenser are not blocked with leaves, dirt, or insets, and clean the hose
connection.
INSPECT GASKET IN FUEL TANK CAP (See page 2AZ-FE: 12-6 , 3MZ-FE 12-23 )
INSPECT FUEL LINES AND CONNECTIONS, FUEL TANK VAPOR VENT SYSTEM HOSES AND
FUEL TANK BANDS (See page 2AZ-FE: 11-1 , 3MZ-FE: 11-35 )
Visually check the fuel lines for cracks, leakage, loose connections, deformation or tank band looseness.
INSPECT EXHAUST PIPES AND MOUNTINGS
Visually check the pipes, hangers and connections for severe corrosion, leaks or damage.
INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE (See page 2AZ-FE: 14-6 , 3MZ-FE: 14-127 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3785
99-6
MAINTENANCE
-
BRAKE
BRAKE
9901M-07
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
P09958
1.
INSPECT BRAKE LINE PIPES AND HOSES
HINT:
Check in a well-lighted area. Check the entire circumference
and length of the brake hoses using a mirror as required. Turn
the front wheels fully right or left before checking the front brake.
(a) Check all the brake lines and hoses for:
Damage
Wear
Deformation
Cracks
Corrosion
Leaks
Bends
Twists
(b) Check all the clamps for tightness and connections for
leakage.
(c) Check that the hoses and lines are clear of sharp edges,
moving parts and the exhaust system.
(d) Check that the lines install in grommets pass through the
center of the grommets.
2.
INSPECT FRONT BRAKE PADS AND DISCS
(See page 32-23 )
HINT:
If a squealing or scraping noise is heard from the brake while
driving, check the pad wear indicator.
If there are traces of the indicator contacting the disc rotor, the
disc pad should be replaced.
S02432
3.
4.
INSPECT REAR BRAKE PADS AND DISCS (See page 32-29 )
INSPECT OR CHANGE BRAKE FLUID (See page 32-4 )
Fluid: SAE J1703 or FMVSS No.116 DOT3
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3786
99-7
MAINTENANCE
-
CHASSIS
CHASSIS
9902V-01
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT STEERING LINKAGE
Check the steering linkage for looseness or damage.
Check that:
Tie rod ends do not have excessive play.
Dust seals and boots are not damaged.
Boot clamps are not loose.
(b) Inspect the dust cover for damage.
2.
INSPECT STEERING GEAR HOUSING OIL
(a) Check the steering gear housing for oil leakage.
If leakage is found, check for cause and repair it.
3.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT BALL JOINTS AND DUST COVERS
Inspect the ball joints for excessive looseness.
Maximum ball joint vertical play: 0 mm (0 in.)
Check the dust cover for damage.
Dust Cover
D25091
4.
(a)
INSPECT DRIVE SHAFT BOOTS
Inspect the drive shaft boots for clamp looseness, grease
leakage or damage.
D25092
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
INSPECT TRANSAXLE FLUID (See page 40-2 )
Canada:
REPLACE TRANSAXLE FLUID (See page 40-2 )
INSPECT TRANSFER OIL (See page 31-4 )
Canada:
REPLACE TRANSFER OIL (See page 31-4 )
INSPECT AND REPLACE LSD OIL (w/ LSD)
(See page 29-5 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3787
99-8
MAINTENANCE
10.
(a)
-
CHASSIS
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL OIL (4WD only)
Remove the filler plug and touch inside the hole with your
finger. Check that the oil comes to within 5 mm (0.20 in.)
of the bottom edge of the hole. If the level is low, add oil
until it begins to flows out of the filler hole.
Grade: See page 29-5
Drain Plug
D25093
11.
12.
Canada:
REPLACE DIFFERENTIAL OIL (4WD only)
(See page 29-5 )
ROTATE TIRES (See page 28-1 )
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3788
99-9
MAINTENANCE
-
BODY
BODY
9901B-15
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Canada:
TIGHTEN BOLTS AND NUTS ON CHASSIS AND BODY
Where necessary, tighten all the parts of the chassis.
Front axle and suspension
Drive train
Rear axle and suspension
Brake system
Engine mounting, etc.
Where necessary, tighten all the parts of the body.
Seat belt system
Seats
Doors and hood
Body mountings
Fuel tank
Exhaust pipe system, etc.
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING FILTER
Remove the glove compartment assembly.
Remove the filter case by holding both sides.
Remove the filter from the filter case.
Replace the filter with a new one.
The installation is in the reverse order of the removal.
2005 HIGHLANDER REPAIR MANUAL (RM1144U)
Author:
Date:
3789